WelcomeIP Address Lookup

What's going on here?

Visitors total: 10,676 (today: 157)
( 7 user online last 15 min. )

Promotion:
Present Your sAPP here -
totally non-binding & free of charge
"

learn more about OPS!

Site-Report

learn more about Tricktresor

learn more about CuDocu

learn more about T.O.B.I.

Just have a look
&
order a book
Don't try phone but buy phone
then your phone is my phone:
iPhone

You already know your IBAN (the Terrible)?

Our actual sAPPs - effective recommendation pays off!

3rd-Party sAPPs

Who asks is leading! Who answers too!

Translated & titled SAP®-Classes beginning with ...:  A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X

(other catalogues & languages)

Explanation for column T (Classtype):
C = Class, I = Interface
Object Type Name               T Component name                Tittel                                                      .

IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I ACTIVATE_CHANGE_CONTEXT       Activate Change Context Data                                .
IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I ACTIVATE_KEYS                 Activate Key List Data                                      .
IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I BEFORE_SAVE                   Before Saving                                               .
IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I LOCK                          Lock (Not Required?)                                        .
IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IFC2DIR_ADMIN                  I UNLOCK                        Unlock (Not Required?)                                      .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_ADMIN_AGENT               Gets an Admin. Agent Instance                               .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_CHANGE_CONTEXT            Gets a Change Context Handler Instance                      .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_CHANGE_HANDLER            Gets a Change Handler Instance                              .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_CHECK_AGENT               Gets a Check Agent Instance                                 .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_MAINTAIN_AGENT            Gets a Change Agent Instance                                .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_MESSAGE_HANDLER           Gets a Message Handler Instance                             .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_READ_AGENT                Gets a Read Agent Instance                                  .
IFC2DIR_AGENT_FACTORY          I GET_READ_SERV_AGENT           Gets an Instance of Read Agent for Service IF               .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I ACTIVATE                      Activate Change Context                                     .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I ADD_DATA                      Add Data (Only Database Data, No Changes)                   .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Triggers Checks at Event BeforeSave                         .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I DELETE_DATA                   Delete Data Records                                         .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_C2GUID_FOR_ESI_ID         Gets C2GUID for an ESI ID                                   .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_C2GUID_FOR_SEMKEY         Gets C2GUID for an External Key                             .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_DATA                      Gets Data from Buffer or DB for Selection Condition         .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_DATA_BY_ESI_IDS           As GET_DATA, for List of ESI-IDs (in int. C2S data format)  .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_DELETED_DATA              Gets inactive data records, flagged as deleted              .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I GET_ESIKEY_FOR_SEMKEY         Gets ESi key field (GUID) for an external key               .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I INSERT_DATA                   Add New Data Records                                        .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I IS_DATA_IN_BUFFER             Checks whether there is a Data Record in the Buffer         .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I QUERY_INACTIVE                Gets Changed Data from Buffer, Active/Inactive from DB      .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER                 I UPDATE_DATA                   Change Data Records                                         .
IFC2DIR_BUFFER_FACTORY         I GET_BUFFER                    Gets Instance for Transactional Buffer                      .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I ARE_DS_IN_CHANGE_CONT         Check Data Records in Change Context                        .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I GET_CHANGE_CONTEXTS           Get Change Context                                          .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I GET_CHANGE_CONTEXT_FOR_USER   Find Change Context for User                                .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I GET_CURRENT_CHNG_CONT         Get Current Change Context                                  .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I IS_DS_IN_CHANGE_CONT          Check Daten Record in Change Context                        .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I IS_USER_IN_CHNG_CONT          Is User in Change Context?                                  .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I SET_DSTS_INTO_CHNG_CONT       Put Several Data Records in Change Context                  .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONTEXT         I SET_DS_INTO_CHANGE_CONT       Put Data Record in Change Context                           .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONT_INT        I CLEAN_CONTEXTS                Delete user entries for non-existent contexts               .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONT_INT        I DELETE_CHANGE_CONTEXT         Delete Current Change Context                               .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONT_INT        I FILTER_DATA_BY_CH_CONT        Filters Data by Change Context                              .
IFC2DIR_CHANGE_CONT_INT        I GET_DS_FROM_CHANGE_CONT       Gets Data Records from Change Context                       .
IFC2DIR_CONFIG_ASSEMBLY        I ACTIVATE_CONFIG_LINK          Activate Assembly Entries                                   .
IFC2DIR_CONFIG_ASSEMBLY        I CREATE_CONFIG_LINK            Create Assembly Entry                                       .
IFC2DIR_CONFIG_ASSEMBLY        I DELETE_CONFIG_LINK            Delete Assembly Entry                                       .
IFC2DIR_CONFIG_ASSEMBLY        I GET_CFG_LINKS_FOR_TERM        Get Assembly Entry for Term                                 .
IFC2DIR_CONFIG_ASSEMBLY        I SAVE_CONFIG_LINK              Save Assembly Entry                                         .
IFC2DIR_EXIT_FACTORY           I GET_NODE_EXIT                 Gets Instance for Exit Interface                            .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I CLEAR_BUFFER                  Resets Transactional Buffer                                 .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I CREATE                        Creates New Data                                            .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I DELETE                        Flags Data for Deletion                                     .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I GET_C2GUID_FOR_ESI_ID         Gets C2GUID for an ESI ID                                   .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I GET_C2GUID_FOR_SEMKEY         Gets C2GUID for an External Key                             .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I READ_DATA_ACT_INACT           Reads Active and Inactive Data                              .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I SELECT_FOR_CHANGE             Reads Data for Processing from Persistence                  .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I SELECT_FOR_CHANGE_BY_RELATION Reads Data of a Subnode for Proc. from Persistence          .
IFC2DIR_MAINTAIN               I UPDATE                        Changes Existing Data                                       .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I ADD_METADATA                  Metadata of Selected Data Records from DB in Meta-Buffer    .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I GET_META_FOR_GUIDS            Gets Metadata for GUID List from Meta-Buffer or DB          .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I GET_META_FOR_SEL              Gets Metadata for Selection Cond. from Meta-Buffer or DB    .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I INSERT_META                   Add Metadata for New Data Rcords in Meta-Buffer             .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I SAVE_META                     Save Metadata and Delete in Meta-Buffer                     .
IFC2DIR_META_BUFFER            I UPDATE_META                   Insert/Change Metadata for Changed Data Records             .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I ADD_METADATA                  Add Metadata (Only Database Data, No Changes)               .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I ADD_TO_GUID_SEM_KEY_MAPPING   Adds a data record to the mapping GUID "-" semantic key     .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I DEL_FROM_GUID_SEM_KEY_MAPPING Deletes a Data Record from Mapping GUID "-" Semantic Key    .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_CHANGED_METADATA          Gets Changed Metadata                                       .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_GUID_FOR_KEY              Gets a GUID for a Semantic Key                              .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_INSERT_METADATA           Gets the Data Records to be Inserted                        .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_MDATA_FOR_MARK_AS_DELETED Gets the Data Records to be Flagged as Deleted              .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_MDATA_FOR_UNDO_DELETE     Gets the Data Records to Reset Delete Flag                  .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_METADATA_FOR_DELETE       Gets the Metadata to be Deleted                             .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_METADATA_FOR_GUIDS        Gets All Metadata of an Instance for GUID List              .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_METADATA_FOR_SEMKEY       Gets All Metadata of an Instance for Semantic Key           .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I GET_UPDATED_METADATA          Gets the Data Record to be Updated                          .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I INSERT_METADATA               Enter Metadata                                              .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I MARK_METADATA_AS_DELETED      Change Metadata                                             .
IFC2DIR_META_NODE_INST         I UPDATE_METADATA               Change Metadata                                             .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I ADD_DATA                      Add Data (Only Database Data, No Changes)                   .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I CHECK                         Check the Changed Data of an Instance                       .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I CLEAR_CHANGE_FLAGS            Reset Change Flag (e.g. After Save)                         .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_ACTIVATE_DELETE_DATA      Gets the Inactive Deleted Data Records                      .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_ACTIVATE_INSERT_DATA      Gets the Inactive New Data Records                          .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_ACTIVATE_UPDATE_DATA      Gets the Inactive Changed Data Records                      .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_BY_ESI_ID                 Gets All Data of an Instance for Semantic Keys              .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_BY_FULL_SPECIFIED_KEY     Gets All Data of an Instance for Semantic Keys              .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_CHANGED_DATA              Gets the Changed Data of an Instance                        .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_DATA_FOR_DELETE           Gets the Data Records of an Instance to be Deleted          .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_DATA_FOR_GUIDS            Gets All Data of an Instance for a GUID List                .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_DATA_FOR_MARK_AS_DELETED  Gets the Data Records Flagged for Deletion                  .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_DATA_FOR_UNDO_DELETE      Gets the Data Records to Reset Delete Flag                  .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_GUID_FOR_ESI_ID           Gets a GUID for an ESI ID and Meta-Context                  .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_GUID_FOR_KEY              Gets a GUID for a Semantic Key and Meta-Context             .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_INSERT_DATA               Gets the New Data Records for an Instance                   .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I GET_UPDATED_DATA              Gets the Changed Data Records for an Instance               .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I INSERT_DATA                   Insert Data                                                 .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I MARK_DATA_AS_DELETED          Delete Data (Data is only flagged as deleted)               .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I SET_ACTIVE                    All Data Records are Flagged as Active                      .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST              I UPDATE_DATA                   Change Data                                                 .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST_FACTORY      I GET_META_NODE_INST            Gets Node Instance for Meta-Buffer                          .
IFC2DIR_NODE_INST_FACTORY      I GET_NODE_INST                 Gets Node Instance for Data-Buffer                          .
IFC2DIR_READ                   I READ_CHILD_DATA               Gets Active Data for a Subnode from the C2 Directory        .
IFC2DIR_READ                   I READ_DATA                     Gets Active Data from the C2 Directory                      .
IFC2DIR_READ_SERV_IF           I READ_DATA_AT_APPL_RT          Reads Active Data at Application Runtime                    .
IFC2DIR_REPOSITORY_ADAPTER     I APPLY_CONFIGURATION           Put Configuration Record in C2 Directory                    .
IFC2DIR_REPOSITORY_ADAPTER     I EXPORT_NODE_CONFIGURATION     Create Configuration Record from Configuration Node Contents.
IFC2DIR_REP_ADAPT_FACTORY      I GET_REP_ADAPT                 Get Repository Adaptor                                      .
IFC2DIR_TERM_FACTORY           I GET_TERM_DESCRIPTOR           Gets a Term Descriptor                                      .
IFC2DIR_TERM_FACTORY           I GET_TERM_HANDLER              Gets an Instance of a Term Handler                          .
IFC2DIR_TERM_HANDLER           I CREATE_TERM_TARGET_INST       Create Data in Term Target Node                             .
IFC2DIR_TERM_HANDLER           I DELETE_TERM_TARGET_INST       Delete Data in Term Target Node                             .
IFC2DIR_TERM_HANDLER           I UPDATE_TERM_TARGET_INST       Change Data in Term Target Node                             .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I CHECK                         Check Data for Time-Dependence                              .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I CHK_DATES_NOT_INITIAL         Check that Date Fields are Not Initial                      .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I HANDLE_DELETE                 Handle Time-Dependency after Deletion                       .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I HANDLE_INSERT                 Handle Time-Dependency after Insertion                      .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I HANDLE_UPDATE                 Handle Time-Dependency after Update                         .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP               I INIT                          Handle Time-Dependency after Deletion                       .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_EK_MAPPING_TAB_TYPE       Gets Table Type for the Index via External Key              .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_END_DATE_FIELD            Gets the Name of the End Date Field                         .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_START_DATE_FIELD          Gets the Name of the Start Date Field                       .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_SYS_HIGHDATE              Gets System Start Date                                      .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_SYS_LOWDATE               Gets System Start Date                                      .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I GET_TIME_DEP_TYPE             Gets the Time-Dependency Type                               .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I IS_TEXT_TIME_DEPENDENT        Are Node Texts Time-Dependent?                              .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_DESCRIPTOR    I IS_TIME_DEPENDENT             Is a Node Time-Dependent?                                   .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_FACTORY       I GET_TDEP_DESCRIPTOR           Gets a Time-Dependence Descriptor                           .
IFC2DIR_TIME_DEP_FACTORY       I GET_TDEP_HANDLER              Gets an Instance of a Time-Dependency Handler               .
IFC2DIR_TYPE_FACTORY           I GET_EXTERNAL_SORT_TAB_TYPE    Gets external sorted table type for C2 data                 .
IFC2DIR_TYPE_FACTORY           I GET_EXTERNAL_TAB_TYPE         Gets External Table Type for C2 Data                        .
IFC2DIR_TYPE_FACTORY           I GET_EXTERNAL_TYPE             Gets External Data Type for C2 Data                         .
IFC2PERS_FACTORY               I GET_META_PERS_ADAPTER         Gets Persistence Adaptor for Meta Data                      .
IFC2PERS_FACTORY               I GET_PERS_ADAPTER_MAINT        Gets Persistence Adaptor for Configuration Object           .
IFC2PERS_FACTORY               I GET_PERS_ADAPTER_READ         Gets Persistence Adaptor for Read Access                    .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I ACTIVATE_DELETE               Activate Deletions                                          .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I ACTIVATE_INSERT               Activate Inserted Data                                      .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I ACTIVATE_UPDATE               Activate Changes                                            .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I COPY_ENTITIES                 Copy Entries                                                .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I DELETE_ENTITIES               Deletion of Entries                                         .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I INSERT_ENTITIES               Insert Entries                                              .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I MARK_AS_DELETED               Flag as Deleted                                             .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I SET_INACTIVE                  Deactivate                                                  .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I UNDO_MARK_AS_DELETED          Flag as Deleted                                             .
IFC2PERS_MAINT                 I UPDATE_ENTITIES               Change Entries                                              .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I DELETE_DATA                   Deletes Meta Configuration Data                             .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I INSERT_DATA                   Write Meta Configuration Data                               .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I MARK_DATA_AS_DELETED          Write Meta Configuration Data                               .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I READ_DATA                     Read Meta Configuration Data                                .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I UNDO_MARK_AS_DELETED          Write Meta Configuration Data                               .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I UPDATE_DATA                   Write Meta Configuration Data                               .
IFC2PERS_META_DATA             I WRITE_DATA                    Write Meta Configuration Data                               .
IFC2PERS_READ                  I APPLICATION_QUERY             Read Active Config. Data at Application Runtime             .
IFC2PERS_READ                  I APPLY_TDEP_TO_FOUND_DATA      TDEP: Time-Dependency Analysis of Data                      .
IFC2PERS_READ                  I READ_ACTIVE_DATA              Read Active Configuration Data                              .
IFC2PERS_READ                  I READ_DELETED_DATA             Read Data Flagged for Deletion                              .
IFC2PERS_READ                  I READ_INACTIVE_DATA            Read Inactive Configuration Data for Change Context         .
IFC2REP_REPOSITORY             I IMPLEMENT_C2_FROM_REP         Copy Config. Record from C2 Rep. into C2 Directory          .
IFC2REP_REPOSITORY             I INSERT_CS_INT_REP             Create Configuration Record in C2 Repository                .
IFC2REP_REPOSITORY             I READ_CS_INT_REP               Read Configuration Record in C2 Repository                  .
IFC2REP_REPOSITORY             I UPDATE_CS_INT_REP             Change Configuration Record in C2 Repository                .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK                I CHECK_NODE_BEFORE_ACTIVATE    Checks before Activation                                    .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK                I CHECK_NODE_BEFORE_SAVE        Checks before Saving                                        .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK                I CHECK_NODE_ON_CREATE          Checks at Creation                                          .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK                I CHECK_NODE_ON_DELETE          Checks at Deletion                                          .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK                I CHECK_NODE_ON_UPDATE          Checks at Change                                            .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK_NODE_BEF_ACT   I CHECK_NODE_BEFORE_ACTIVATE    Checks before Activation                                    .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK_NODE_BEF_SAVE  I CHECK_NODE_BEFORE_SAVE        Checks before Saving                                        .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK_NODE_ON_CREATE I CHECK_NODE_ON_CREATE          Checks at Creation                                          .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK_NODE_ON_DELETE I CHECK_NODE_ON_DELETE          Checks at Deletion                                          .
IFC2SEXIT_CHECK_NODE_ON_UPDATE I CHECK_NODE_ON_UPDATE          Checks at Change                                            .
IFC2SEXIT_TERM_CHANGE          I CHANGE_TARGET_FROM_TERM       Data Change in Target Node Depending on Term                .
IFC2SEXIT_TERM_TARGET_CHANGE   I UPDATE_TERM_FROM_TARGET       Data Change in Term Depending on Target Node                .
IFC2SEXIT_VALUE_DELETE         I COMPLETE_DATA_DELETE          Complete Deletions                                          .
IFC2SEXIT_VALUE_INIT           I COMPLETE_NEW_DATA             Complete New Data                                           .
IFC2SEXIT_VALUE_UPDATE         I COMPLETE_DATA_UPDATE          Add to Data Changes                                         .
IFUR_D2                        I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IFUR_D2_SYSTEM                 I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IF_ABAP_GZIP_BINARY_HANDLER    I USE_OUT_BUF                   Output Buffer Handler                                       .
IF_ABAP_GZIP_TEXT_HANDLER      I USE_OUT_BUF                   Output Buffer Handler                                       .
IF_ABAP_UNGZIP_BINARY_HANDLER  I USE_OUT_BUF                   Output Buffer Handler                                       .
IF_ABAP_UNGZIP_TEXT_HANDLER    I USE_OUT_BUF                   Output Buffer Handler                                       .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I GET_CHANGED_MODEL             Model to be Used for Notification of Changes                .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I GET_EXKN                      Supply Account Assignment Structure                         .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I GET_EXKNX                     Supply Change Structure for Account Assignment Structure    .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Posted account assignment data procured                     .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Account Assignment Data Prior to Validation             .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I RECEIVE_FROM_COBL             Get Data from Account Assignment (Coding) Block             .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I SEND_TO_COBL_AT_PAI           Supply Account Assignment (Coding) Block in PAI             .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I SEND_TO_COBL_AT_PBO           Supply Account Assignment (Coding) Block in PBO             .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I SET_EXKN                      Set Account Assignment Structure                            .
IF_ACCOUNTING_MODEL_MM         I SET_EXKNX                     Set Change Structure for Account Assignment Structure       .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I CREATE_ASSETS                 Create Assets                                               .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I CREATE_ITEM                   Generate and Add New Account Assignment Object              .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_CATEGORY                  Determine Account Assignment Category                       .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_COMPANY_CODE              Company Code                                                .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_DATA                      Header Account Assignment Data (Sales Order, Network,...)   .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_DEFAULT_VIEW              Customizing: Single or Multiple Account Assignment View     .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_DISTRIBUTION_INDICATOR    Distribution Indicator                                      .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_ITEMS                     Return Account Assignment Objects                           .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_PART_INVOICE_INDICATOR    Read Partial Invoice Indicator                              .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_QUANTITY                  Distributable Quantity                                      .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I GET_REPETITION                What is the Status of Repeat Account Assignment?            .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I IS_ACTIVE                     Account Assignment Active for This Object?                  .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I LOOKUP                        Determine Account Assignment from Delivery Number           .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I REMOVE_ITEM                   Remove Account Assignment Object                            .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I SET_CATEGORY                  Set Account Assignment Category                             .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I SET_DISTRIBUTION_INDICATOR    Change Distribution Indicator                               .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I SET_PART_INVOICE_INDICATOR    Set Partial Invoice Indicator                               .
IF_ACCT_CONTAINER_MM           I SET_REPETITION                Switches Repeat Account Assignment (On/Off/All Off)         .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I DELETE_ACCSYS                 Deletes Transferred Accounting System                       .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_AREA_STATIC               Gets Area ID Statically                                     .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_CHART_ACCOUNTS            Gets Chart of Accounts                                      .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_CURRENCY_TYPES_STATIC     Gets Currency Types                                         .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_DATABASIS_STATIC          Gets Data Basis                                             .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Attributes                                        .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_FISCAL_YEAR_VARIANT_STATICGets Fiscal Year Variant                                    .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_REF_VALUATION_RULE        Gets the Rule for a Reference Valuation                     .
IF_ACC_ACCSYS                  I GET_TEXT                      Long Text accsys                                            .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I DELETE_DATABASIS              Deletes Transferred Data Basis                              .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_ACCSYS                    Gets All Posting Relevant Accounting Systems (Buffered)     .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_ACCSYS_BY_CONDITION       Gets All Accounting Systems for a Data Basis with Condition .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_ACC_CONFIG_STATIC         Gets Accounting Configuration                               .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_ACC_SYSTYPE_STATIC        Gets System Type                                            .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_AREA_STATIC               Gets AREAID Statistically (to Instantiate Char. Service)    .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_DATABASIS_STATIC          Determine Corresponding Data Basises from Area ID           .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_DATABASIS_TXT_STATIC      Read Texts for a Data Basis                                 .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_IOBC_NAMES                Gets Info Catalogs                                          .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_RFCDEST_EXT               Gets RFCDEST                                                .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I GET_SEL_CHARS_FOR_ACCSYS      Returns the Selection Characteristics to the Acc. Systems   .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I IS_MAINTAINABLE               Checks if possible to maintain / automatic transport        .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I REGISTER_FIELDS               Registers InfoObjects or Local Characteristics in Data Basis.
IF_ACC_DATABASIS               I TRANSPORT_AREAID              AREAID Transport                                            .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS_INT           I GET_ACCSYS_INT                Fetches All Accounting Systms (for Corresponding Selections).
IF_ACC_DATABASIS_INT           I GET_KF_CHAR_LIST_USED_LOCALLY Characteristics Used in Technical Components                .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS_INT           I GET_RFCDEST                   Fetches RFC                                                 .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS_INT           I GET_RFCDEST_STATIC            Fetches RFCDEST                                             .
IF_ACC_DATABASIS_INT           I SET_RFCDEST                   Sets New RFC Destinations for AREAID                        .
IF_ACC_DEBCRED_ROLE            I GET_VALUE_CREDIT              Gets Value for Credit                                       .
IF_ACC_DEBCRED_ROLE            I GET_VALUE_DEBIT               Gets Value for Debit                                        .
IF_ACC_GL_ACCOUNT_CALLBACK_1   I CHECK_DELETABILITY            Check if an account can be deleted                          .
IF_ACC_GL_ACCOUNT_ROLE         I CHECK_BLOCKED_FOR_POSTING     Checks Wether an Account is Blocked for Posting             .
IF_ACC_GL_ASSGNMT_TYPE         I GET_ACC_ASSGNMT_INFO          Read Account Assignment Category                            .
IF_ACC_LOG_OBJ_CAT             I GET_CHAR_NAMES                Fetches List of Characteristic Names Assigned to Object Type.
IF_ACC_LOG_OBJ_CAT             I GET_KF_CHAR_STRUCTURE         Delivers KF_CHAR_STRUCTURE Instance of a Logistical Obj Type.
IF_ACC_LOG_OBJ_CAT             I GET_STRUCTURE_NAME            Delivers Structure Name of Logistical Object Type           .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I CHECK_PERIOD_ABS_CLOSED       Checks That the Period is Completely Closed                 .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I CHECK_PERIOD_CLOSED           Checks That the Period is Closed                            .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I CONCATENATE_YEAR_PERIOD       Joins Fiscal Year and Period                                .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I DETERMINE_PERIOD_DIFFERENCE   Finds the Required Period                                   .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I DET_PERIOD_FROM_DATE          Finds the Period to Which a Day Belongs                     .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_DAYS_IN_PERIOD            Finds the Days in a Period                                  .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_FIRST_DAY_OF_PERIOD       Finds the First Day of a Period                             .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_FIRST_DAY_OF_YEAR         Finds the First Day of a Fiscal Year                        .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_LAST_DAY_OF_PERIOD        Finds the Last Day of a Period                              .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_LAST_DAY_OF_YEAR          Finds the Last Day of a Fiscal Year                         .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_NEXT_OPEN_PERIOD          Finds the Next Open Period                                  .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_SELECTION_CONDITION       Permitted Selection Conditions per Accounting System        .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I GET_SELECTION_FIELDS          Permitted Selection Conditions per Accounting System        .
IF_ACC_PERIOD                  I SPLIT_YEAR_PERIOD             Separates Fiscal Year and Period                            .
IF_ACC_ROLE                    I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers Instance of the Object that Fills a Roll           .
IF_ACC_TECH_COMP               I GET_COMPONENT_NAME            Provides Component Name in Text Form                        .
IF_ACC_TECH_COMP               I GET_INTEGRATED_KF_CHARS       Provides Lis of Required Characteristics of the Component   .
IF_ACC_TECH_COMP               I GET_KF_CHAR_LIST_USED_LOCALLY Provides Kist of Field Names of the Used Chars and Key Figs .
IF_ACC_TECH_COMP               I GET_TERMINATOR                Provices Delete Class Instance for Deletion of Local Content.
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I COPY                          Copy Authorization                                          .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I COPY_CONTENTS                 Copy Activites for Authorization Holders                    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I DELETE                        Delete Entire ACO from DB                                   .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I DELETE_HR_OBJECT              Delete HR Organizational Unit from ACO                      .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I DELETE_ROLE                   Delete Role from ACO                                        .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I DELETE_USER                   Delete User from ACO                                        .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I DELETE_USER_GROUP             Delete User Group from ACO                                  .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I FREE                          Delete Entire ACO, Delete Entry in Persistence Layer        .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_AUTHORIZATION_BY_USER     Provide Authorization Object                                .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_AUTHORIZATION_FOR_USER    Get List of All Authorizations for a User                   .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_CHANGES_FOR_OBJECT        Get "Change Documents"                                      .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_HANDLE                    Retrieve Handle                                             .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_OBJECT                    Provide Object                                              .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_PERMISSION_LIST           Get List with All Authorizations                            .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I GET_USERS                     Get List of All Users                                       .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I HAS_AUTHORITY                 User Has Authorization for Activity                         .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I HAS_CHANGED                   ACL was changed                                             .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I HAS_EXCLUSIVE_AUTHORIZATION   User Has Authorization for Activity                         .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I HAS_EXTENDED_AUTHORITY        User Has Extended Authorizations for Activity               .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_AUTHORITY_FOR_HR_OBJECT Reset Authorization of an HR Organization Unit for Activity .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_AUTHORITY_FOR_ROLE      Reset Authorization of Role for Activity                    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_AUTHORITY_FOR_USER      Reset User Authorization for Activity                       .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_AUTHORITY_FOR_USER_GROUPReset User Group Authorization for Activity                 .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_EXCLUSIVE_AUTHORIZATION Reset Exclusive Authorization                               .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_INCLUSIVE_AUTHORIZATION Withdraw Transfer of Authorization                          .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I RESET_TEMPLATE                Switch Off Template Mode                                    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_AUTHORITY_FOR_HR_OBJECT   Set Authorization of HR Organizational Unit for Activity    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_AUTHORITY_FOR_ROLE        Set Role Authorization for Activity                         .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_AUTHORITY_FOR_USER        Set User Authorization for Activity                         .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_AUTHORITY_FOR_USER_GROUP  Set User Group Authorization for Activity                   .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_DEL_USR_SELF              User Can Delete Itself: Switch On                           .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_EXCLUSIVE_AUTHORIZATION   Set Exclusive Authorization                                 .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_INCLUSIVE_AUTHORIZATION   Transfer Authorization from Other Object                    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_PARENT_AUTHORIZATION      Set Parent Authorization                                    .
IF_ACO_AUTHORIZATION           I SET_TEMPLATE                  Switch On Template Mode                                     .
IF_ACO_COMMON                  I GET_AUTHORIZATION             Retrieve Authorization                                      .
IF_ACO_COMMON                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description (Sort Text)                                 .
IF_ACO_COMMON                  I GET_ID                        Get Internal Object ID                                      .
IF_ACO_COMMON                  I GET_NAME                      Get External Object ID                                      .
IF_ACO_COMMON                  I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Get Object Type                                             .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description (Sort Text)                                 .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I GET_ID                        Get Internal Object ID                                      .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I GET_MEMBER_TYPE               Get Authorization Holder Type (User, User Group,...)        .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I GET_NAME                      Get External Object ID                                      .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I GET_USER_IDS                  Get User IDs                                                .
IF_ACO_MEMBER_INFO             I IS_MEMBER                     User is in group                                            .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I DELETE_ALL_TRIGGERS_FOR_OBJECTDelete All Actions of an Object                             .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I DETERMINE                     Start Action Determination                                  .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I GET_ACTIONS                   Read Actions                                                .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I GET_ACTIONS_FOR_TOOLBAR       Read Action for Toolbar                                     .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I GET_EXECUTION_MODE            Read Processing Mode                                        .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I PROCESS_ACTIONS               Process Actions                                             .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I REFRESH                       Clear                                                       .
IF_ACTIONS_PPF                 I SET_APPLKEY                   Set Semantic Application Key                                .
IF_ACTION_BRF                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_ACTION_BRF                  I PREPARE                       Creates (Sub)Tree of Expressions                            .
IF_ACTION_BRF                  I SET_ACTION                    Sets Action                                                 .
IF_ACTION_BRF                  I SET_PROCESSOR                 Sets Action Processor                                       .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I CREATE_ACTION_DEF             Generates an Action Definition                              .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I DELETE_ACTION_DEF             Deletes an Action Definition                                .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I GET_ACTION_DEF                Reads an Action Definition                                  .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I GET_ACTION_DEFS               Delivers Action Definitions for an Action Profile           .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I GET_PROFILE_OF_ACTION_DEF     Returns the Action Profile for an Action Definition         .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I MODIFY_ACTION_DEF             Changes an Action Definition                                .
IF_ACTION_CUST_PPF             I TRANSPORT_ACTION_DEFINITION   Writes an Action Definition to a Transport Request          .
IF_ACTION_HANDLER_POC          I ADD_ACTION_TRIGGER            Assign Action Trigger                                       .
IF_ACTION_HANDLER_POC          I DEREGISTER_EVENTS             Deregisters Global and Local Events                         .
IF_ACTION_HANDLER_POC          I HANDLE_GLOBAL_EVENT           Global Event Triggered                                      .
IF_ACTION_HANDLER_POC          I REGISTER_EVENTS               Registers Local and Global Events                           .
IF_ACTION_HANDLER_POC          I UPDATE_TRIGGER_TAB            Adjust Trigger Table after Status Change                    .
IF_ACTION_POC                  I EXECUTE                       Executes Action                                             .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I ACTIVATE                      Activate Action                                             .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I DEACTIVATE                    Delete Action                                               .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I EXECUTE                       Execute Action                                              .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_ACTION_DEFINITION         Read Action Definition                                      .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_ACTION_DEFINITION_DESCR   Read Description of Action Definition                       .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_ACTION_DEFINITION_LONGTEXTRead Long Text for Action Definition                        .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_APPLICATION               Read Application                                            .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_APPLKEY                   Read Application Key                                        .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_CHANGEABLE                Read Changeability                                          .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_CONTEXT                   Read Context                                                .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_DATA_STRUCT               Read Attribute as Structure                                 .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_DATECHANGE                Read Change Date                                            .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_DATECREATE                Read Creation Date                                          .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_DISPATCH                  Read Processing Time                                        .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_EXECANDDEL                Read 'Delete After Execution'                               .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_EXECDIALOG                Read 'Action Is Executable in the Dialog'                   .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_IS_CHANGED                Read Change Indicator                                       .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_IS_INACTIV                Read Active Indicator                                       .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_IS_MCREAT                 Read Manual Creation Indicator                              .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_IS_REPEAT                 Read Repeat Indicator                                       .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_MEDIUMDESC                Read Processing Description                                 .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PARTINDEP                 Read Partner Dependency                                     .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING                Read Processing                                             .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING_DESCR          Read Processing Description                                 .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING_LOG            Read Processing Log                                         .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING_TYPE           Read Processing Type                                        .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING_TYPE_DESCR     Read Description of Processing Type                         .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_SORTFIELDS                Read Sort Fields                                            .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_STARTCOND_DATA            Get Data of Start Condition                                 .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_START_CONTAINER           Read Parameter in Start Condition                           .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_STATUS                    Read Status                                                 .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_TIMECHANGE                Read Change Time                                            .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_TIMECREATE                Read Creation Time                                          .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_TOOLBAR                   Read Toolbar Indicator                                      .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_TTSORT                    Read Display Sorting                                        .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_USERCHANGE                Read Changer                                                .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I GET_USERCREATE                Read Creater                                                .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I PREVIEW                       Action Preview                                              .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I REPEAT                        Repeat Action                                               .
IF_ACTION_PPF                  I SET_START_CONTAINER           Set Changed Parameters in Start Condition                   .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I CREATE_PROCESSING             Generates Action Processing                                 .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I DELETE_ALL_PROCESSING         Deletes All Action Processing                               .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I DELETE_PROCESSING             Deletes an Action Processing                                .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I GET_PROCESSING                Reads an Action Processing                                  .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I GET_PROCESSINGS               Returns Action Processing for an Action Definition          .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I MODIFY_PROCESSING             Changes an Action Processing                                .
IF_ACTION_PROCESSING_CUST_PPF  I TRANSPORT_PROCESSING          Writes the Action Processing into a Transport Request       .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CONF_PPF     I ADD_TEMPLATE_FROM_CUST        Inserts an Action Template to Profile Following Customizing .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CONF_PPF     I COPY_TEMPLATE                 Copies an Action Template                                   .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CONF_PPF     I DELETE_TEMPLATE               Deletes an Action Template                                  .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CONF_PPF     I GET_ALL_TEMPLATES_OF_PROFILE  Returns all Action Templates of a Profile                   .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CONF_PPF     I TRANSPORT_TEMPLATE            Transports an Action Template                               .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I CREATE_PROFILE                Generates an Action Profile                                 .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I DELETE_PROFILE                Deletes an Action Profile                                   .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I GET_APPL_OF_PROFILE           Returns the Application for an Action Profile               .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I GET_PROFILE                   Reads an Action Profile                                     .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I GET_PROFILES                  Delivers an Action Profile for an Application               .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I MODIFY_PROFILE                Changes an Action Profile                                   .
IF_ACTION_PROFILE_CUST_PPF     I TRANSPORT_PROFILE             Writes the Action Profile into a Transport Request          .
IF_ACTION_TODO_TRG             I DO                            Carry Out Activity                                          .
IF_ACTION_TODO_TRG             I RESET                         Resets Activity                                             .
IF_ACTION_TRIGGER_POC          I GET_DETAILS                   Outputs Detail Information about Trigger                    .
IF_ACTION_TRIGGER_POC          I RAISE_EVENT_FROM_EXTERNAL     Trigger Event Externally                                    .
IF_AC_IMODE_POC                I SET_INPUTMODE_OPTIONAL        Set Input Mode to "Optional Entry Field"                    .
IF_AC_IMODE_POC                I SET_INPUTMODE_REQUIRED        Set Input Mode to "Required Entry Field"                    .
IF_AC_IMODE_POC                I SET_STATE_ERROR               Set Field Status to "Incorrect Value"                       .
IF_AC_IMODE_POC                I SET_STATE_OK                  Set Field Status to "Value OK"                              .
IF_AC_LABEL_POC                I SET_LABEL                     Set Text                                                    .
IF_AC_LABEL_POC                I SET_TOOLTIP                   Set Tooltip (Quickinfo)                                     .
IF_AC_MISC_POC                 I SCROLL_INTO_VIEW              Scroll Component to Visible Area                            .
IF_AC_MISC_POC                 I SET_FOCUS                     Set Input Focus to Component                                .
IF_AC_SIGNATURE_POC            I ADD_SIGNATURE                 Add Executed Signature to Display                           .
IF_AC_SIGNATURE_POC            I REMOVE_SIGNATURES             Remove all Signatures from Display                          .
IF_AC_TABLE_POC                I APPEND_ROWS                   Add Lines at the End of Table                               .
IF_AC_TABLE_POC                I DELETE_ROWS                   Delete Lines at the End of Table                            .
IF_AC_TABLE_POC                I GET_HEADER_TEXT               Get Column Headings                                         .
IF_AC_TABLE_POC                I SET_HEADER_TEXT               Set Column Headings                                         .
IF_AC_TABLE_POC                I SET_NUMBER_OF_ROWS            Change Number of Lines                                      .
IF_AC_VALUEHELP_POC            I IS_DEFAULT_VALUE              Get Default Value                                           .
IF_AC_VALUEHELP_POC            I SET_DEFAULT_VALUE             Set Default Value                                           .
IF_AC_VALUEHELP_POC            I SET_VALUE_HELP                Switch On/Off / Define Input Help                           .
IF_AC_VALUE_POC                I GET_VALUE                     Get Value                                                   .
IF_AC_VALUE_POC                I SET_VALUE                     Set Value                                                   .
IF_AC_VMODE_POC                I SET_VIEW_ACTIVE               Set Display Mode to "Active/Normal"                         .
IF_AC_VMODE_POC                I SET_VIEW_DISABLED             Set Display Mode to "Not Available/Gray"                    .
IF_AC_VMODE_POC                I SET_VIEW_INACTIVE             Set Display Mode to "Inactive/Not Ready for Input"          .
IF_ADAPTER_RFW                 I GET_ADAPTER_TEXT              Get Adapter Description                                     .
IF_ADAPTER_RFW                 I GET_NODETYPES                 Get Node Types                                              .
IF_ADAPTER_RFW                 I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_ADAPTER_RFW                 I READ_GRAPH                    OBSOLETE !!!                                                .
IF_ADAPTER_RFW                 I SELECT_GRAPH                  Selection of Graphs to be Read                              .
IF_ADDRESS_ENHANCEMENT_SERVICE I ENHANCE_ADDRESSES             Add Data to Address                                         .
IF_AES_MEMORY_SAVE             I MEMORY_SAVE                   IF for Persistence Service in Address Enhancement Services  .
IF_AFTER_PERSISTANCE           I VARIFY_OUTGOING_DATA          Data after package manager in the SyncService MI_HOST       .
IF_AI_ATTACHMENT               I GET_BINARY_DATA               Gets Attachment as xstring (always possible)                .
IF_AI_ATTACHMENT               I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Attachment Type (image/jpeg, text/html,...)                 .
IF_AI_ATTACHMENT               I GET_KIND                      Attachment Type: String Conversion Possible/Not Possible    .
IF_AI_ATTACHMENT               I GET_TEXT_DATA                 Gets Attachment as String - Only Possible for Kind = Text   .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I GET_ATTACHMENTS               Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I GET_FROM_PARTY                Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I GET_INPUT_PAYLOAD             Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I GET_MESSAGE_ID                Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I GET_OUTPUT_PAYLOAD            Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I RESET_ATTACHMENTS             Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I SET_ATTACHMENTS               Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I SET_FROM_PARTY                Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I SET_SERIALIZATION_CONTEXT     Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AI_POSTING_CONTROLLER       I SET_TO_PARTIES                Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_AKB_COLLECTION_QUERY        I GET_OBJECTLIST                Display Object List                                         .
IF_AKB_COLLECTION_QUERY        I GET_SUCCESSORS                Ascertain Node Successor                                    .
IF_AKB_COLLECTION_QUERY        I LOOKUP_EDGE                   Insert an Object Reference                                  .
IF_AKB_INTERFACE_QUERY         I GET_STATE                     Interface Status                                            .
IF_AKB_OBJECT                  I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Environment Analysis                                        .
IF_AKB_OBJECT                  I GET_INFO                      Query Object info                                           .
IF_AKB_OBJECT                  I GET_VERSION                   Read Version from Version Database                          .
IF_AKB_OBJECT                  I SET_UP                        Constructor                                                 .
IF_AKB_OBJECT                  I TEAR_DOWN                     Destructor                                                  .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I GET_AS_STRUCTURE              Returns Data as Structure                                   .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I GET_DESCRIPTION               Delivers the Name                                           .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I GET_URL                       Delivers the URL                                            .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I GET_URL_TYPE                  Returns the Type of URL                                     .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I SET_AS_STRUCTURE              Sets the Data from a Structure                              .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets the Name                                               .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I SET_URL                       Sets the URL                                                .
IF_ALERT_ACTIVITY_API          I SET_URL_TYPE                  Sets the Type of the URL                                    .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I CREATE_ACTIVITY               Generates a New Follow-On Activity                          .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I CREATE_ALERT_RECIPIENT        Generates a New Alert Recipient                             .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I DELETE_ACTIVITY               Deletes a Follow-On Activity                                .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I DELETE_ALERT_RECIPIENT        Deletes an Alert Recipient                                  .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ACTIVITIES                Returns all follow-on activities                            .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ACTIVITY                  Returns a Follow-On Activity for a Key                      .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ALERT_RECIPIENT           Returns an Alert Recipient for a Key                        .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ALERT_RECIPIENTS          Returns all Alert Recipients                                .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ALIAS                     Returns the Alias of the Category                           .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_AS_STRUCTURE              Returns Object Data as a Structure                          .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_CLASSIFICATION            Returns Alert Classification of the Category                .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns Description of the Category                         .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_DEVCLASS                  Returns the application package of the category             .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ESCALATION                Returns Escalation Mechanism                                .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_EXPIRY_TIME               Returns Expiry Time for the Alerts of the Category          .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_MAX_DELIVERY              Returns Maximum Number of Delivery Attempts                 .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_ORIGLANG                  Returns the original language of the category               .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_PRIORITY                  Returns Priority of the Category                            .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_STATIC_TEXTS              Returns the Used Static Texts                               .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_TECHNICAL_NAME            Returns Technical Name of the Category                      .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_USE_DYNAMIC_TEXT          Returns Flag for Use of Dynamic Text                        .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I GET_WORKFLOW_CONTAINER        Returns Workflow Container                                  .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_ALIAS                     Sets Alias of the Category                                  .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_AS_STRUCTURE              Sets Object Data from a Structure                           .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_CLASSIFICATION            Sets Alert Classification of the Category                   .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets Description of the Category                            .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_DEVCLASS                  Sets the application package of the category                .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_EXPIRY_TIME               Sets Expiry Time for the Alerts of the Category             .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_MAX_DELIVERY              Sets Maximum Number of Delivery Attempts                    .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_ORIGLANG                  Sets the original language of the category                  .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_PRIORITY                  Sets Priority of the Category                               .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_USE_DYNAMIC_TEXT          Sets Flag for the Use of Dynamic Text                       .
IF_ALERT_CATEGORY_API          I SET_WORKFLOW_CONTAINER        Sets Workflow Container                                     .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_INTERFACE Returns Interface for External Alert Systems                .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_PROCESSING_MODE           Returns Mode of Alert Processing                            .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_REQUESTED_STATUS          Returns the Setting for Requested Statuses                  .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_STATUS_DELIVERY_BY_MAIL   Returns Setting for Delivery Status by Mail                 .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_USER_INBOUND_PROCESSING   Returns Alert User for Inbound Processing                   .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I GET_WRITE_PROTOCOL            Returns Check Indicator for Logging                         .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SAVE_CHANGES                  Saves the Changes                                           .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SET_PROCESSING_MODE           Sets Mode of Alert Processing                               .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SET_REQUESTED_STATUS          Sets Setting for Requested Statuses                         .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SET_STATUS_DELIVERY_BY_MAIL   Sets Setting for Delivery Status by Mail                    .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SET_USER_INBOUND_PROCESSING   Sets Alert User for Inbound Processing                      .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I SET_WRITE_PROTOCOL            Sets Check Indicator for Logging                            .
IF_ALERT_CENTRAL_SERVER_API    I UNDO_CHANGES                  Discards the Changes                                        .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I GET_ALL_CATEGORIES            Return All Assigned Alert Categories                        .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns Description of Classification                       .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I GET_SUB_CLASSIFICATIONS       Returns All Subclassifications                              .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I GET_SUPER_CLASSIFICATION      Returns Superordinate Classification                        .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I GET_TECHNICAL_NAME            Returns Technical Name of Classification                    .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets Description of Classification                          .
IF_ALERT_CLASSIFICATION_API    I SET_SUPER_CLASSIFICATION      Sets Superordinate Classification                           .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I CREATE_ESCALATION_RECIPIENT   Generates a New Escalation Recipient                        .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I DELETE_ESCALATION_RECIPIENT   Deletes the Escalation Recipient                            .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I GET_DELAY                     Returns the Tolerance Time                                  .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I GET_ESCALATION_RECIPIENT      Returns the Escalation Recipient                            .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I GET_IS_ACTIVE                 Returns Flag for Activating and Deactivating Escalation     .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I SET_DELAY                     Sets Tolerance Time                                         .
IF_ALERT_ESCALATION_API        I SET_IS_ACTIVE                 Sets Flag for Activating and Deactivating Escalation        .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_ADD_ACTIVITIES_XML        Returns Check Indicator for Activity Transmission           .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_ADD_RECIPIENTS_XML        Returns Check Indicator for Recipient Transmission          .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_ADD_TEXTS_XML             Returns Check Indicator for Text Transmission               .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_ALLOW_XML_PERSONALIZATION Returns Check Indicator for XML Forwarding Option           .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_CATEGORY_CHECK_XML        Returns Check Indicator for Category Check                  .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_HTTP_DESTINATION          Returns HTTP Destination of External Alert System           .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I GET_SMTP_ADDRESS              Returns SMTP Address of External Alert System               .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_ADD_ACTIVITIES_XML        Sets Check Indicator for Activity Transmission              .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_ADD_RECIPIENTS_XML        Sets Check Indicator for Recipient Transmission             .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_ADD_TEXTS_XML             Sets Check Indicator for Text Transmission                  .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_ALLOW_XML_PERSONALIZATION Sets Check Indicator for XML Forwarding Option              .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_CATEGORY_CHECK_XML        Sets Check Indicator for Category Check                     .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_HTTP_DESTINATION          Sets HTTP Destination of External Alert System              .
IF_ALERT_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM_API   I SET_SMTP_ADDRESS              Sets SMTP Address of External Alert System                  .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_ALERT_ALIAS               Returns Alias of Alert Category                             .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_ALERT_CATEGORY            Returns Alert Category                                      .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_ALERT_CATEGORY_DESCRIPTIONReturns Description of Alert Category                       .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_EVENT_NAME                Returns Name of Event                                       .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_EVENT_OBJECT_CATEGORY     Returns Category of Event (BOR, ABAP Class...)              .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I GET_EVENT_OBJECT_TYPE         Returns Object Type of Event (BOR Type, ...)                .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I RAISE_EVENT                   Triggers Event                                              .
IF_ALERT_LOCAL_EVENT           I SET_ACTIVATION_FLAG           Sets Activation Indicator                                   .
IF_ALERT_RECIPIENT_API         I GET_RECIPIENT_TYPE            Returns Recipient Type                                      .
IF_ALERT_RECIPIENT_API         I GET_USER_LIST                 Returns Recipient(s) as List of Internal Users              .
IF_ALERT_RECIPIENT_API         I IS_ESCALATION_RECIPIENT       Is recipient an escalation recipient                        .
IF_ALERT_ROLE_API              I GET_ROLE_NAME                 Returns the Technical Name of Role                          .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I CHECK_RULE                    Checks the Rule                                             .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I EDIT_BINDING                  Calls the Control Editor for the Data Flow                  .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I EXECUTE_RULE                  Evaluates Recipient Rule                                    .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I GET_BINDING                   Returns Data Flow Between Alert Container and Rule Container.
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I GET_RULE_ID                   Returns Rule ID                                             .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I GET_RULE_TYPE                 Returns Rule Type                                           .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I SET_BINDING                   Sets Data Flow Between Alert Container and Rule Container   .
IF_ALERT_RULE_API              I SET_RULE_ID                   Sets the Rule ID                                            .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I GET_LONG_TEXT                 Returns Long Text                                           .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I GET_NO_ALERT_ID               Returns Control Flag for ID in Text                         .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I GET_SHORT_TEXT                Returns Short Text                                          .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I GET_TITLE                     Returns Title                                               .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I SET_LONG_TEXT                 Sets the Long Text                                          .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I SET_NO_ALERT_ID               Sets Control Flag for ID in Text                            .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I SET_SHORT_TEXT                Sets Short Text                                             .
IF_ALERT_TEXT_API              I SET_TITLE                     Sets Title                                                  .
IF_ALERT_USER_API              I GET_USER_NAME                 Returns the Technical User Name                             .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I CREATE                        Create Control                                              .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I DISPLAY                       Display Hit List                                            .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I FREE                          Release Control                                             .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I GET_SELECTED_HITS             Return Selected Hits                                        .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I GET_TREE_HITLIST              Return Tree Hit List                                        .
IF_ALINK_BO_DOCUMENT_TREE_VIS  I REFRESH                       Restructure Tree                                            .
IF_ALINK_ERR_FLAG              I SET                           Set Error Flag                                              .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I CHECK_CONTROL_EXISTENCE       Check Whether Control Exists                                .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I CREATE                        Generate Display Control for the Display Container          .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I DISPLAY                       Display Control                                             .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I FREE                          Re-Release Display Control                                  .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I GET_SELECTED_HITS             Selected Hit in Control                                     .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I REFRESH                       Refresh Selected Hit                                        .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST               I REFRESH_TREE                  Refresh Whole Tree                                          .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST_CALLBACK      I GET_SUBDIRECTORY_HITLIST      Return Hits Behind a Sub-Directory                          .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST_CALLBACK      I LOAD_CONTEXT_MENU             Display Selected Documents                                  .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST_CALLBACK      I PROCESS_CONTEXT_MENU          Execute Function Selected From Context Menu.                .
IF_ALINK_HITLIST_CALLBACK      I PROCESS_DOUBLE_CLICK          Execute Double-Click on a Hit                               .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I DISPLAY_HITLIST_CONTROL       Carry Out Hit List Display in Control                       .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I EXPORT_TO_RM                  Export to Record                                            .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I FREE_HITLIST_CONTROL          Release Hit List Display Tool                               .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GENERATE_QUERYMASK            Generate Search Query Template for Attributes               .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Return Attributes for Hit                                   .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GET_DOCUMENT_ATTRIBUTES       Return Definition of Document Attributes                    .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GET_HITLIST                   Return Hit List Together with Attributes                    .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GET_SUBDIRECTORY_HITLIST      Return Hit List Behind Hit                                  .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I GET_URL                       Return URL for Displaying a Hit                             .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I INITIALIZE                    Actual Constructor of Classes                               .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I IS_FTS_ACTIVE                 Full Text Search Possible                                   .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I PERFORM_SEARCH                Execute Search Query To Search Engines                      .
IF_ALINK_QUERY                 I SET_IMAGE_CONTAINER           Set Container for Screen Display if Inplace Implemented     .
IF_ALINK_QUERY_RECORDS         I GET_RM_OBJECTS_FROM_HITS      Return RM Object List Based on TOARSDOC_S Entries           .
IF_ALINK_RECORD_MANAGER        I GET_SELECTED_DOCUMENT         Return Exactly One Selected Document                        .
IF_AMORTIZATION_CALCULATOR_CAL I CALCULATE_VALUE               Calculates the New Amortized Acquisition Value              .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I GET_TABLE                     Supply Table                                                .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I INSERT_LINE                   Insert Row                                                  .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I INSERT_LINES                  Insert Lines                                                .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I IS_INITIAL                    Table Initial?                                              .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I MODIFY_LINE                   Modify Line Generically                                     .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I READ_LINE                     Read Line                                                   .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I READ_LINES                    Read Rows                                                   .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I REFRESH                       Reset table                                                 .
IF_ANY_TABLE_MM                I SET_TABLE                     Set Table                                                   .
IF_APB_LAUNCHPAD_SETVAL        I RESOLVE_SET                   Resolve Set                                                 .
IF_APB_LPD_ADDIOTIONAL_OBJECTS I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Get list with additional ojectfolders                       .
IF_APB_LPD_MODIFY_OBJ_TYPE     I MODIFY_OBJECT_TYPE            Modify or change object type                                .
IF_APL_ECATT_EXECUTION         I CHECK                         Checking of Script of Executable eCATT Object               .
IF_APL_ECATT_EXECUTION         I EXECUTE                       Execution of Script of Executable eCATT Object              .
IF_APL_ECATT_EXECUTION         I GET_DESTINATION               Get RFC Destination                                         .
IF_APL_ECATT_EXECUTION         I RESET_EXEC                    Reset Attributes Relevant for Execution                     .
IF_APL_ECATT_F4                I GET_VALUES                    Get Values for Field                                        .
IF_APL_ECATT_F4                I SET_VALUES                    Set values                                                  .
IF_APL_ECATT_OBJ_USAGE         I GET_WATCH_FIELDS              Get Fields Whose Change Is Registered in the XML Editor     .
IF_APL_ECATT_OBJ_USAGE         I UPDATE_USAGE_INFO             Get and Enter Where-Used List Info                          .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_EVENTS     I RAISE_EV_FIELD_VAL_CHANGED    Resolve Event EV_FIELD_VAL_CHANGED                          .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I GET_SYSTEM_DATA_REF           Query System Data Container Object                          .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I GET_TESTSYS_MAINTAIN          Get SD Container/Target System for Maintenance              .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I GET_VAR_EXT                   Query Settings for Using External Variants                  .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I INIT_PARAMS                   Initializes Local Data Container for eCatt Module           .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameter Object Reference                              .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I SET_TESTSYS_MAINTAIN          Set SD Container/Target System for Maintenance              .
IF_APL_ECATT_PARAMS_USAGE      I SET_VAR_EXT                   Make Settings for Using External Variants                   .
IF_APL_ECATT_UI_CONTROL        I CLOSE                         Exit UI Control                                             .
IF_APL_ECATT_UI_CONTROL        I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_APL_ECATT_UI_CONTROL        I HIGHLIGHT_CONTROL             Highlighting a Control for Display                          .
IF_APL_ECATT_UI_CONTROL        I RESCON                        Reset Connections                                           .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I APPEND                        Append Rows to Table                                        .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I CLEAR                         Empty Table Row                                             .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I DELETE                        Delete Row                                                  .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get Properties                                              .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I GET_ELEMENT_INFO              Node Attributes in XML Instance                             .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_DATA          I SET_VALUE                     Set Value                                                   .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_SCHEMA        I LOOKUP_TYPE                   Examine Meta Data                                           .
IF_APL_ECATT_XML_SCHEMA        I VALIDATE                      Validate Schema                                             .
IF_APPLCLASS_SERVICES_BRF      I GET_DEFAULT_CURRENCY          Determines Standard Currency                                .
IF_APPLCLASS_SERVICES_BRF      I REGISTER_EVENTS               Register Events for User Interaction                        .
IF_APPLCLASS_SERVICES_BRF      I WHERE_USED                    Where-Used List for BRF Objects in the Application          .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I ACTIVATE                      Follow-up actions after including appl. obj. in hierarchy   .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I CLEAR_CHG_IND                 Clears change indicator                                     .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I CLEAR_KEY                     Clears key field(s) of application object                   .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I CLEAR_NODE                    Clears reference to OHF node                                .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I GET_CHG_IND                   Gets change indicator                                       .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I GET_KEY                       Gets key of application object                              .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I GET_LOG_KEY                   Gets key of application log                                 .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I GET_NODE                      Gets node                                                   .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I GET_TYPE                      Gets type                                                   .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I INACTIVATE                    Follow-up actions after removing appl. obj. from hierarchy  .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I KEY_TO_STRING                 Returns string representation of application object key     .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I LOCK                          Locks application object                                    .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I RE_READ                       Re reads the old state of the application object            .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I SET_CHG_IND                   Sets change indicator                                       .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I SET_KEY                       Sets key of application object                              .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I SET_NODE                      Sets node                                                   .
IF_APPL_OBJ_OHFW               I UNLOCK                        Releases lock on application object                         .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I CLEAR                         Delete Object Attributes                                    .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I GET_PREDECESSOR               Supplies Link Source                                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Supplies Link Target                                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I SET_PREDECESSOR               Set Source Link                                             .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK             I SET_SUCCESSOR                 Set Link Source                                             .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_LINK_INTERNAL    I GET_DATA_FOR_NETPLAN          Provides Link Structure                                     .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I CLEAR                         Delete Table Object Attributes                              .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I DELETE_ROW                    Delete Row in Table                                         .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I GET_TABLEDATA                 Provides Data Table for Table Object                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I GET_TITLE                     Provides Table Title                                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I INSERT_ROW                    Insert Row in Table                                         .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_CELL_PROPERTIES           Set 2 Cell Properties                                       .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_COLUMN_PROPERTIES         Set 1 Column Properties                                     .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_ROW_PROPERTIES            Set 2 Row Properties                                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_TABLEDATA                 Insert 1 Table Data                                         .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_TABLE_ATTRIBUTES          Set 1 Table Attributes                                      .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_TABLE_PROPERTIES          Set Table Properties                                        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_TABLE_STATUS              Set 1 Table Status                                          .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE            I SET_TITLE                     Set Table Title (Also Possible via Table Properties)        .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERNAL   I GET_TABID                     Provides Table Object ID                                    .
IF_AQQGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERNAL   I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_ARC_PM_PLAN_CHECK           I CHECK                         Enhance Checks on Task List                                 .
IF_ARC_PM_PLAN_DELETE          I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data                                      .
IF_ARC_PM_PLAN_WRITE           I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive File                       .
IF_ARC_SD_VBRK_DEL             I DEL                           Delete Technical Additional Data                            .
IF_ARC_WB2_CHECK               I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_ARC_WB2_DELETE              I DELETE                        Delete Data                                                 .
IF_ARC_WB2_WRITE               I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_ACTIVE_PASSIVE            Gets the Position Category (Asset/Liability)                .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_COMPONENTS                Gets the Position's Components                              .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_COMPONENT_VALUES          Gets the Position's Values                                  .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_CURRENCIES                Gets Position and Valuation Currencies                      .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_DIFF_VALUES               Gets Values for the Differentiation Characteristics         .
IF_ASSESSABLE_POSITION_VAL     I GET_POS_MAN_PROC              Gets the Position Management Procedure for the Position     .
IF_ASYNC_SUBJECT_MM            I GET_CHANGES                   Get Changes                                                 .
IF_ASYNC_SUBJECT_MM            I PUBLISH                       Publish                                                     .
IF_ASYNC_SUBJECT_MM            I RESET_CHANGES                 Reset Change Buffer                                         .
IF_AS_ITERATOR                 I CLOSE                         Close Iterator                                              .
IF_AS_ITERATOR                 I NEXT                          Deliver Next Element                                        .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I BUILD_ATP_CATALOGUE           MMPUR_ATP_CATALOGUE_EXTRACT                                 .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I GET_ATPCS                     Populates ATPCS                                             .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I GET_KEY                       Returns Material Key                                        .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I GET_SAME_MATERIAL             Populates ATPCS w. Lock Records of Other Items w. Same Mat. .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I GET_SCHEDULE_BY_KEY           Get Schedule Line for ATP from Business Logic               .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I IS_VALID                      Checks Validity of Rule                                     .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I SET_COMMITTED_QUANTITY        Updates Confirmed Quantity and Confirmed Date               .
IF_ATP_CHECK_MM                I SUBTRACT_REQUISITIONS         Populates ATPCS with Release Records of Assigned Requisition.
IF_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_DME        I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Read Attributes by Name                                     .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_DME        I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Set Attributes by Name                                      .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_MV_DB             I GET_MV_ATTR_VALUES_HISTORY    Reads All Historical Values of a Multi-Value Attribute      .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_MV_DB             I GET_MV_ATTR_VALUES_SINGLE     Reads All Values of a Multi-Value Attribute per Set         .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_MV_DB             I SET_MV_ATTR_VALUES            Changes the Value of a Multi-Value Attribute                .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_PROCESSOR         I PREPARE_BITEM_ATTRIBUTE       Prepares an Object Attribute                                .
IF_ATTRIBUTE_PROCESSOR         I PREPARE_LINK_ATTRIBUTE        Prepares a Relationship Attribute                           .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST             I RUN                           Execute Tests of a Test Class                               .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I CLEAR_CONTEXT                 Delete Explicitly Set Context                               .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I METHOD_END                    End of a Test Method                                        .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I METHOD_START                  Start of a Test Method                                      .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I SET_CONTEXT                   Report Context Other than Test Method Execution             .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I START_LISTENING               Switch to Listener Mode                                     .
IF_AUNIT_CLASSTEST_RESULT      I STOP_LISTENING                Exit Listener Mode                                          .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ACTUAL               Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ACT_TABLE_INITIAL    Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_BOUND         Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_BOUND_TYPE    Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_CHAR_CP       Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_CHAR_NP       Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_INITIAL       Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_NOT_BOUND     Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_ASSERT_NOT_INITIAL   Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_COMPARISON           Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DETAIL               Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DIFFERENT_DATA_TYPE  Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DIFFERENT_DATA_VALUE Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DIFF_FLOAT_VALUES    Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DIFF_STRUCTURE       Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_DIFF_STRUCT_COMPONENTAdd specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_EQUAL_DATA_VALUE     Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_EXPECTED             Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_EXPECTED_VS_ACTUAL   Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_EXP_TABLE_INITIAL    Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_INTERN_ERR_EXCEPTION Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_INT_PROBLEM_COMPONENTAdd specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_SEQUENCE_IN_HASH     Different Sequence in Hash Table                            .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_STRING_COMPARISON    Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TAB_DIFF_INDEX       Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TAB_VALUE_DIFFERENT  Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TAB_VALUE_DIFF_INDEX Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TAB_VALUE_MISSING_ACTAdd specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TAB_VALUE_MISSING_EXPAdd specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TYPE_DEEP_STRUCTURE  Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TYPE_FLAT_STRUCTURE  Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TYPE_NUMC            Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_TYPE_TABLE           Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I ANALYSIS_WRONG_SUBRC          Add specific analysis                                       .
IF_AUNIT_FAILURE_ASSERT        I RAISE                         Trigger Check Error                                         .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_END_TASK         I GET_DESCR_TAB                 Supplies Table with All Text Descriptions                   .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_END_TASK         I GET_RUNTIME_DESCR             Supplies Text Description of Runtime Specification          .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_END_TASK         I GET_SUMMARY_DESCR             Returns text description of error summary                   .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_END_TASK         I GET_TESTED_OBJECTS_DESCR      Returns text description of test object overview            .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_FAILURE          I APPEND_ANALYSIS               Add Error Analysis                                          .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_FAILURE          I APPEND_STACK                  Add Error Stack                                             .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_FAILURE          I GET_DESCR_TAB                 Returns the Description for Creating the Information Texts  .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_FAILURE          I GET_LEVEL                     Returns Criticality of a Message                            .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_FAILURE          I SET_TEST                      Test Specifications: Add Program, Class, Method             .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_MESSAGE          I APPEND_ANALYSIS               Add Error Analysis                                          .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_MESSAGE          I APPEND_DOCUMENT_TO_ANALYSIS   Enhances analysis with reference to documentat. in hypertext.
IF_AUNIT_INFO_MESSAGE          I GET_DESCR_TAB                 Returns the Description for Creating the Information Texts  .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_MESSAGE          I GET_DOCUMENTS_OF_ANALYSIS     Returns list of documents in analysis                       .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_MESSAGE          I SET_TEST                      Test Specifications: Add Program, Class, Method             .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_PROBLEM          I IS_OK                         Evaluation, Test Unit OK?                                   .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I APPEND_ANALYSIS               Add Error Analysis                                          .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I APPEND_DOCUMENT_TO_ANALYSIS   Enhances analysis with reference to documentat. in hypertext.
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I GET_DESCR_TAB                 Returns the Description for Creating the Information Texts  .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I GET_DOCUMENTS_OF_ANALYSIS     Returns list of documents in analysis                       .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I GET_LEVEL                     Returns the Error Level                                     .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_RUNTIME          I SET_TEST                      Test Specifications: Add Program, Class, Method             .
IF_AUNIT_INFO_STEP             I GET_DESCR                     Returns Information Description                             .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I ASSERT_FAILURE                Reports Occurrence of a Check Error                         .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I CLASS_END                     Reports End of a Test Class                                 .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I CLASS_START                   Reports Start of a Test Class                               .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I CX_FAILURE                    Reports Occurrence of an Exception Error                    .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I EXECUTION_EVENT               Gives information on execution of test task                 .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I METHOD_END                    Reports End of a Test Method                                .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I METHOD_START                  Reports Start of a Test Method                              .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I PROGRAM_END                   Reports End of a Program                                    .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I PROGRAM_START                 Reports Start of a Program                                  .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I RT_FAILURE                    Reports Occurrence of a Runtime Error                       .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I TASK_END                      Reports End of a Test Task                                  .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I TASK_START                    Reports Start of a New Test Task                            .
IF_AUNIT_LISTENER              I WARNING                       Reports Occurrence of a Warning                             .
IF_AUNIT_TEXT                  I FETCH_RAW_TEXT                Gets the Unprocessed Text                                   .
IF_AUNIT_TEXT                  I FILL_IN_PARAMS                Adds Parameter to Text                                      .
IF_AUNIT_TEXT                  I GET_TEXT                      Gets the Finished Text                                      .
IF_AUTHORIZATION_BRF           I CHECK_AUTHORITY               BRF: Authorization Check                                    .
IF_AUTHORIZATION_BRF           I GET_INSTANCE                  BRF: Transfers an Instance (for Singleton Pattern)          .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I DOUBLE_CLICK                  Double Click on Tree Node...                                .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I DRAG                          Move node using "Drag" technique                            .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I DROP                          Move node using "Drop" technique                            .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I PERFORM_CMD                   Execute function                                            .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I REQUEST_CXT_MENU              Request context menu                                        .
IF_B2E_XMLAPP                  I SHOW_ORIGINAL                 Display original                                            .
IF_B2E_XMLTOOL                 I PERFORM_CMD                   Execute function                                            .
IF_B2E_XMLTOOL                 I REQUEST_CXT_MENU              Request context menu                                        .
IF_B2E_XMLTOOL                 I START                         Start                                                       .
IF_BADI_ADPIC_STO              I CHANGE_SI_CATEGORY            Change subitem category                                     .
IF_BADI_BP_PAYDETAILS_ADD      I BP_PAYMENTDETAILS_ADD         Check and Update Business Partner Payment Details           .
IF_BADI_BP_PAYDETAILS_ADD      I GET_PAYMENT_METHOD            Get Payment Method                                          .
IF_BADI_CAPITAL_FLOW_CA_TRR    I GET_CAPITAL_FLOW              Calculation of Capital Flow                                 .
IF_BADI_CAPITAL_FLOW_TRR       I GET_CAPITAL_FLOW              Calculation of Capital Flow                                 .
IF_BADI_CATS_APPROVAL          I CHECK_APPROVAL_BY_EXCEPTION   Does CATS Record Require Approval?                          .
IF_BADI_CATS_APPROVAL          I DETERMINE_APPROVER            Determines Approver of a CATS Record                        .
IF_BADI_COMPONENT_HANDLING     I PERFORM_LINE_OPERATION        Cut, Insert, Copy Lines                                     .
IF_BADI_COMPONENT_HANDLING     I SAVE_ALL_ENTRIES              Save Entries                                                .
IF_BADI_COMPONENT_HANDLING     I UPDATE_SINGLE_ENTRY           Change a Single Table Entry                                 .
IF_BADI_CONTRACLOCK_DETAIL     I FILL_CTRACPARTNER_LOCK_DETAIL Update Contract Partner Lock Details                        .
IF_BADI_CONTRTPARTRNER_DETAIL  I FILL_CTRACPARTNERDETAIL       Update Contract Partner Details                             .
IF_BADI_DIM_PROXY_METHODS      I GET_BANK_CL_ACCOUNT           Get Bank clearing account                                   .
IF_BADI_DIM_PROXY_METHODS      I GET_DOC_TYPE_CHRGOFF_RES_WTOFFDocument  type and Charge off reason for Write Off          .
IF_BADI_DIM_PROXY_METHODS      I GET_DOC_TYPE_CLR_RES_CLR_CRDT Doc source key, Doc type and Clr reason for Clear from credi.
IF_BADI_DIM_PROXY_METHODS      I GET_DOC_TYPE_CLR_RES_REV_CLR  Document type and Clearing reason for Reversal of clearing  .
IF_BADI_DIM_PROXY_METHODS      I GET_DOC_TYPE_CLR_RES_REV_OI   Document type and Clearing reason for Reversal of open items.
IF_BADI_EHSH_POH_CHECK_AUTH    I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Enhanced Authorization Check                                .
IF_BADI_EHS_DEF_COMPREL        I SET_DEF_COMPREL               EHS: Default for Reference Value                            .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_ACTIONS                   Define Additional Actions                                   .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_ACTION_CONF               Output Confirmation Message for Additional Actions          .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_DETAIL_COMP               Define Detail Component (Implements IFC_POWL_DETAIL)        .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_FIELD_CATALOG             Modify Field Catalog                                        .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_MAX_RESULTS               Max. Number of Material Master Records MARA Read            .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_OBJECTS                   Determine Objects According to Additional Selection Criteria.
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I GET_SELECTION_CRITERIA        Define Additional Definition Criteria                       .
IF_BADI_FEEDER_POWL            I HANDLE_ACTION                 Perform Additional Actions                                  .
IF_BADI_FVD_AUTODRAFT_CREATE   I CHANGE_RESULTS                Change Values in Results Table                              .
IF_BADI_FVD_AUTODRAFT_CREATE   I CREATE_DETAIL_RECORDS         Create Detail Records                                       .
IF_BADI_FVD_AUTODRAFT_CREATE   I CREATE_FOOTER                 Creae Footer Records                                        .
IF_BADI_FVD_AUTODRAFT_CREATE   I CREATE_HEADER                 Create Header Records                                       .
IF_BADI_FVD_MD_MODEL_LOAN      I UDPATE_COMPONENT_SERVICES     Update List of Services for Components                      .
IF_BADI_FVD_MD_MODEL_LOAN      I UPDATE_COMPONENT_LIST         Update List of Active Components                            .
IF_BADI_FVD_MD_VIEW_LOAN       I GET_CUSTOMER_CONDITION_LAYOUT Layout for Customer-Specific Display of Conditions          .
IF_BADI_GM_EXP_DOC             I GM_EXP_DOC                    Export SD doc and DATE_TO to memory                         .
IF_BADI_HUMO                   I PROCESS_FCODE_ALV             Processing Function Codes (Authorization Checks)            .
IF_BADI_HUMO                   I STATUS_SET                    Set Menu Status                                             .
IF_BADI_HU_MAIN                I ASSIGNMENT_CHECK              Check the HU Assignment                                     .
IF_BADI_HU_MAIN                I GM_STATUS_SET                 Set Customer-Specific Status for Goods Movements            .
IF_BADI_HU_MAIN                I HEADER_CHECKS                 Checks when Changing HU Header Attributes                   .
IF_BADI_HU_MAIN                I HEADER_UPDATE_IN_PACKING      Change HU Header Data and Update of Other Data              .
IF_BADI_HU_MAIN                I SELECT                        Additional Selections                                       .
IF_BADI_HU_SAVE                I SAVE                          General Method for Follow-Up Actions                        .
IF_BADI_INFORMATION_READER     I GET_BADI_DEFINITION           Returns Relevant Information for a BAdI Definition          .
IF_BADI_INFORMATION_READER     I GET_BADI_IMPLEMENTATIONS      Returns Table of All BAdI Implementations                   .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT  I CALL_POST_BADI                Call Post-BAdI                                              .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT  I CALL_PRE_BADI                 Call Pre-BAdI                                               .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_AUTHORITY   I CHECK                         Authorization Check                                         .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_CREATE      I CHECK_ADMIN_DATA              Create Document: Check Document Management Data             .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_CREATE      I DOCPART_SET_ADMIN_DATA        Create Document Part: Preset Document Management Data       .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_CREATE      I DOCVERSION_SET_ADMIN_DATA     Create Document Version: Preset Document Management Data    .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_CREATE      I DOC_SET_ADMIN_DATA            Create Document: Preset Document Management Data            .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_PROC        I POST_PROCESSING               After Processing the Document                               .
IF_BADI_ISHMED_DOC_SEND_RECIPT I GET_RECIPIENTS                Determine payee                                             .
IF_BADI_ISH_DWS_FCODE_REQUEST  I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Global Function Code                               .
IF_BADI_ISH_DWS_HEADER_COMP    I MAKE_DWS_HEADER               Create Work Station Header Content                          .
IF_BADI_ISH_DWS_PAT_OVIEW_COMP I MAKE_PATIENT_OVERVIEW         Create Content of Patient Overview                          .
IF_BADI_ISM_AUDITCAT           I REPLACE_AUDITCAT_FROM_DB      Replace Alt. Audit Report Category from Database            .
IF_BADI_ISM_AUDITCAT           I REPLACE_AUDITCAT_FROM_MEMORY  Replace Alt. Audit Report Category from Memory              .
IF_BADI_ISM_AUDITCAT           I SAVE                          Save Alt. Audit Report Category from Memory                 .
IF_BADI_ISM_AUDITCAT           I SET_AUDITCAT_TO_MEMORY        Determine Alt. Audit Report Category and Fill Memory        .
IF_BADI_ISM_CIC_SCRIPTING      I GET_TEXTSYMBOLS               Determine Text Symbols                                      .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Adjust Field Catalog                                        .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I CHANGE_TOOLBAR                Customize toolbar                                           .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I GET_ACTIVITY_TO_OKCODE        Determine Activity for OK Code                              .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA           Determine Additional Data                                   .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I GET_ADDITIONAL_TOOLBAR_OKCODESReturn Additional Toolbar OK Codes                          .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_BUTTON_CLICK           Button Click Handling                                       .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU           Context Menu Handling                                       .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_DOUBLE_CLICK           Double Click Handling                                       .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_HOTSPOT_CLICK          Hotspot Click Handling                                      .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_MENU_BUTTON            Handling for Menu Button in Toolbar                         .
IF_BADI_ISM_MSD_ORDERLIST      I HANDLE_TOOLBAR_COMMAND        Toolbar Command Handling                                    .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I AFTER_ACTION                  After Performing Action                                     .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before Performing Action                                    .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I CHECK_ACCEPT                  Automatic Acceptance                                        .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I CHECK_CURRENT_LEVEL           Check Current Step                                          .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I CHECK_NEXT_LEVEL              Check Next Step                                             .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I DETERMINE_DUEDATE             Determine Due Date                                          .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_MONITORING I PREPARE                       Preparation                                                 .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_OFFER      I CHANGE_OFFER                  Adjust Offer                                                .
IF_BADI_ISM_RENEWAL_OFFER      I GET_DATE                      Determine Date for Offer Creation                           .
IF_BADI_ISM_REN_REMIND_PRESEL  I PRESELECT                     Preselection                                                .
IF_BADI_ISM_REN_REMIND_SCHEMA  I CHECK                         Procedure Can Be Determined                                 .
IF_BADI_ISM_REN_REMIND_SCHEMA  I GET_POSSIBLE_PROCEDURES       Determine Possible Monitoring Procedures                    .
IF_BADI_ISM_REN_REMIND_SCHEMA  I GET_SCHEMA                    Determine Procedure                                         .
IF_BADI_LAMA_FREESELECTIONS    I MATERIAL_NUM_RANGE_CONVERSION Material Number Range Conversion (Note: 615035)             .
IF_BADI_LE_WMS_PSP             I PSP_ALLOWED                   Allow project stock in dec. WMS                             .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I CHANGE_SI_CATEGORY_FB         Set Subitem Category in Case of Fallback                    .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I SCM_PIC_ATPCSX_PO             Change to ATPCSX Depending on Advice Code                   .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I SCM_PIC_FIELD_CATALOGUE_PO    Field Catalog in PO in Case of SCM-ATP w. Prod. Replacement .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I SCM_PIC_FIELD_CATALOGUE_PR    Field Catalog in PR in Case of SCM-ATP w. Prod. Replacement .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I SET_SCM_PIC_DFPS              Decision re PIC in SCM - Depending on Advice Code           .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I SET_SCM_PIC_DFPS_FB           Decision re PIC in Fallback - Depending on Advice Code      .
IF_BADI_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS     I TRIGGER_ATP                   Retrigger ATP                                               .
IF_BADI_MI_SYNCHRONIZATION     I CHECK_BEFORE_PERSISTANCE      BADI before writing Sync data to the Database               .
IF_BADI_MI_SYNCHRONIZATION_2   I CHECK_AFTER_PERSISTANCE       BADI after calling the creating entries in the middleware   .
IF_BADI_PACKAGE_CHANGED        I PACKAGE_CHANGED               Package Changed                                             .
IF_BADI_RCV_BP_ISOLATION       I ADDRESS_DESC_BY_SENDTYPE_GET  Provide Name of Address by Send Type                        .
IF_BADI_RCV_BP_ISOLATION       I MEMBERS_OF_GROUP_GET          Provide Members of Group                                    .
IF_BADI_RCV_BP_ISOLATION       I PARTNER_AND_ADDRESS_DATA_GET  Provide Business Partner and Address Data                   .
IF_BADI_RCV_BP_ISOLATION       I PARTNER_DESC_GET              Provide Name of Business Partner                            .
IF_BADI_RCV_BP_ISOLATION       I SPOUSE_GET                    Provide Spouses                                             .
IF_BADI_ROLEMAN_AUTH_CHECK     I AUTH_DATA_CHECK               Checking Authorizations                                     .
IF_BADI_ROLEMAN_AUTH_GET       I AUTH_DATA_GET                 Determine Authorizations                                    .
IF_BADI_ROLEMAN_AUTH_GET       I AUTH_REF_DATA_GET             Determine Reference Data for Authorizations                 .
IF_BADI_SAPLV56L               I READ_VTRDI_INDX               Read Deliveries for a Transfer Document                     .
IF_BADI_SD_EDI_EDLSCHED        I IDOC_DATA_MODIFY              IDoc Manipulation in Release Receipt                        .
IF_BADI_SORTER                 I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transfer                                               .
IF_BADI_SORTER                 I IS_LAYER_CHANGEABLE           In Change Mode?                                             .
IF_BADI_SORTER                 I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transfer                                               .
IF_BADI_SORTER                 I SET_LAYER_CHANGEABLE          Change Mode                                                 .
IF_BADI_SORTER                 I SORT_IMPLS                    Sort                                                        .
IF_BADI_SYSTEM_FINDER          I GET_RFC_DEST                  Get RFC Destination                                         .
IF_BADI_WDK_ENVIRONMENT        I CHECK_BASIC                   Check Kayak environment by switch                           .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I CLEANUP                       Support for Garbage Collector                               .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I GET_OUT_REF                   Read Out MEOUT Object Instance                              .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I MAP2E                         Outbound Mapping                                            .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I MAP2E_IS2ERP                  Outbound Mapping in ExtensionOut for IS2ERP                 .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I MAP2I                         Inbound Mapping                                             .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I MAP2I_IS2ERP                  Inbound Mapping of ExtensionIn for IS2ERP                   .
IF_BAPI_MEOUT                  I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Set Attributes for MEOUT Function Group                     .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I CLEANUP                       Garbage Collector Support                                   .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I GET_REQ_REF                   Extraction of MEREQ Handle                                  .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I MAP2E                         Outbound Mapping                                            .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I MAP2E_IS2ERP                  Outbound Mapping in ExtensionOut for IS2ERP                 .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I MAP2I                         Inbound Mapping                                             .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I MAP2I_IS2ERP                  Inbound Mapping of ExtensionIn for IS2ERP                   .
IF_BAPI_MEREQ                  I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Transfer of Data to MEREQ Object                            .
IF_BBY_NR_RANGE_EXT            I CHECK_AGAINST_EXT_NR_RANGE    Verification Against External Number Range Interval         .
IF_BCA_MDIM_LOANS_RFC          I FILL_CTRACPARTNERDETAIL       Fill contract partner details                               .
IF_BCB_ADDRESS                 I GET_CHANNEL                   get channel of the address                                  .
IF_BCB_CONTAINER               I ADD_ITEM                      Add an item                                                 .
IF_BCB_CONTAINER               I DELETE_ITEM                   Deletes a single Item from Container                        .
IF_BCB_CONTAINER               I GET_CHANNEL                   Get Channel Type                                            .
IF_BCB_CONTAINER               I GET_ITEM                      Get a single Item in Container                              .
IF_BCB_CONTAINER               I GET_ITEMS                     Get all Items in Container                                  .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I FILL_SAVE_BUFFER              Save all personal attributes before save in internal buffer .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I REACT_ON_UNDO                 Responds to "undo"                                          .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I RETURN_BOR_KEY                Delivers the BOR key for the object                         .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I RETURN_SEM_KEY                Delivers semantic key of the object                         .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I SAVE                          Saving data not entered by Persistence Service              .
IF_BCM_SAVE                    I TIME_SEGMENT                  Write new time segment?                                     .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I FILL_SAVE_BUFFER              Save all personal attributes before save in internal buffer .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I LOCK                          CM Private: Lock an Object for Change                       .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I REACT_ON_UNDO                 Responds to "undo"                                          .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I REFRESH                       CM private: Deleting all save-relevant buffers again        .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I SAVE                          CM private: Saving data not entered by Persistence Service  .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I TIME_SEGMENT                  Write new time segment?                                     .
IF_BCM_SAVE2                   I UNLOCK                        CM Private: Unlock Object                                   .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I CREATE                        Create a structure - MANDATORY!                             .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I CREATE_FOR_PROPAGATED_FOLDER  Create structure if successor is in another life cycle phase.
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I CREATE_SUCCESSOR_STRUCTURE    Creation of successor structure: Successor in ONE phase     .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I DELETE                        Delete the structure of a product folder                    .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I FINISH_BASELINE               End Baseline process                                        .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I GET_ADMIN_INFO                Mapped the attribute of instance in a structure             .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I GET_COMPLETE_STRUCTURE        Return entire structure table                               .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I GET_STRUCTURE_KEY             Reset the structure key                                     .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I IS_USED                       Where-used list: is an object in a structure?               .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I LOAD                          Display the structure of a product folder                   .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I PREPARE_FOR_BASELINE          Prepare structure for Baselining (complete...)              .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I SAVE                          Save the structure of a product folder                      .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I SET_ADMIN_INFO                Mapped the structure in attribute of instance               .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I SET_COMPLETE_STRUCTURE        Transfering entire structure table                          .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE               I UNDO                          Undoes the changes to the object                            .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE_VISITOR       I END_VISIT                     Callback After Reading                                      .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE_VISITOR       I START_VISIT                   Callback Before Reading                                     .
IF_BCM_STRUCTURE_VISITOR       I VISIT_CM_STRUCTURE            Callback for the Structure Read                             .
IF_BCM_TRAVERSAL               I TRAVERSAL_BREADTH_FIRST       Traversng Structure: With Increasing Level                  .
IF_BCM_TRAVERSAL               I TRAVERSAL_POST_ORDER          Traversing Structure: Post Order - (Parent Last)            .
IF_BCM_TRAVERSAL               I TRAVERSAL_PRE_ORDER           Traversing Structure: Pre Order - (Parent First)            .
IF_BCOM_MIME                   I AS_MIME                       Return of MIME Representation of a Document                 .
IF_BCOM_R_REQUEST_CALLBACK     I SET_AGENT_LIST                Transfer Result of Routing to Application                   .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I GET_LANGUAGES                 Gets All BC Set Text Languages                              .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I GET_RECORD                    Gets Changed Table Records                                  .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I GET_TABLE                     Gets Changed Table Contents                                 .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I GET_TABLE_KEYS                Gets Table Keys                                             .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I GET_TABNAMES                  Gets Table Names                                            .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I ISSUE_MESSAGE                 Send Message                                                .
IF_BCSET_ACTIVATION            I REJECT_RECORD                 Reject Table Record                                         .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FIX_CHANGE    Check Authorization to Change Fixed Values                  .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I CHECK_FIELD                   Checks Whether a Field Can be Changed                       .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I DISPLAY_LOCK_INFO             Shows the Locking BC Set                                    .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_ALL_LOCKS                 Gets All Fixed Fields                                       .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_FIELD_LOCKS               Gets the Fixed Fields for a Row                             .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_TABKEYS                   Gets the Key (External Format)                              .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_TABKEY_EXTERNAL           Gets the External Table Key                                 .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_TABKEY_INTERNAL           Gets the Internal Table Key                                 .
IF_BCSET_TABLE_LOCKS           I GET_TABLE_KEYS                Gets Key (Typed)                                            .
IF_BEFORE_PERSISTANCE          I VARIFY_INCOMING_DATA          Update data coming from the client                          .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I ACROSS_SUBCLTYPE_TOPS         Iterate across the top nodes that are cross subclaim        .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I GET_COVERED_COVTYPES          Get the subclaim types that lie under a benefit type        .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I GET_COVERED_SUBCLTYPES        Get the subclaim types that lie under a benefit type        .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_COVTYPE_BENTYPES         Loop over nodes that are cross subclaim type                .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_COVTYPE_TOPS             Iterate across the top nodes of each subclaim type          .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_CROSSSUBCLT_NODES        Loop over nodes that are cross subclaim type                .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_CROSS_COVTYPE_BENTYPES   Loop over nodes that are cross subclaim type                .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_SUBCLTYPE_BENTYPES       Loop over nodes that are cross subclaim type                .
IF_BENTYPE_TREE_ICL            I LOOP_SUBCLTYPE_TOPS           Iterate across the top nodes of each subclaim type          .
IF_BFW_CLIENT_POC              I LOAD_XML_DOCUMENT             Take XML Document for Display                               .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_CTMENU               Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_EXEC                 Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_IMODE                Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_LABEL                Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_MISC                 Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_SIGNATURE            Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_TABLE                Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_VALUE                Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_VALUEHELP            Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_COMPONENT_POC           I QUERY_IF_VMODE                Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_CTHANDLER_POC           I EXECUTE                       Execute Command                                             .
IF_BFW_CTHANDLER_POC           I GET_MENU                      Get Menu Definition                                         .
IF_BFW_CTHANDLER_POC           I GET_STATE                     Get Menu Status                                             .
IF_BFW_CTMENU_POC              I GET_HANDLER                   Get Registered Users                                        .
IF_BFW_CTMENU_POC              I SET_HANDLER                   Register Menu Users                                         .
IF_BFW_CTMENU_POC              I UPDATE_MENU                   Notification: Menu Structure Was Changed                    .
IF_BFW_CTMENU_POC              I UPDATE_STATE                  Notification: Status of Entries Was Changed                 .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I CANCEL_CLOSING                Cancel Closing of Document (Event: document_closing)        .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I PRINT                         Open Browser Dialog for Printing                            .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I QUERY_IF_CTMENU               Query Reference to Interface                                .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I REFRESH                       Reload but do not Create New Proxies                        .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I REPLACE                       Replace Own W3 Resources                                    .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I REQUEST_CLOSING               Restart Document Closing after "Cancel_Closing"             .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I REQUEST_RELOAD                Trigger Reloading with New Proxies after "cancel_closing"   .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I SHOW_MODAL_DIALOG             Display Modal Dialog                                        .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I SHOW_MODELESS_DIALOG          Display Modeless Dialog                                     .
IF_BFW_DOCUMENT_POC            I W3REQUEST_COMPLETE            Confirmation of Requested W3 Resource                       .
IF_BGRFC_CLIENT                I DELETE_FAILED_UNIT            Deletes Unit with Errors                                    .
IF_BGRFC_CLIENT                I GET_UNIT_STATE                Gets State of Background RFC Unit                           .
IF_BGRFC_CLIENT                I RUN_FAILED_UNIT               Restarts Unit with Errors                                   .
IF_BGRFC_DEBUG_UNIT            I LOCK_DUE_DEBUG_REQUEST        Create Debugging Lock                                       .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_INBOUND   I CREATE_QRFC_UNIT              Factory Method for Generating Inbound qRFC Unit             .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_INBOUND   I CREATE_TRFC_UNIT              Factory Method for Generating Inbound tRFC Unit             .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_OUTBOUND  I CREATE_QRFC_UNIT              Factory Method for Generating Outbound qRFC Unit            .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_OUTBOUND  I CREATE_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND   Factory Method for Generating Outbound/Inbound qRFC Unit    .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_OUTBOUND  I CREATE_TRFC_UNIT              Factory Method for Generating Outbound tRFC Unit            .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I DELETE                        Remove Destination from Internal Data Structures            .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I GET_EMERGENCY_RESOURCES       Specify Last Resources Used                                 .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I GET_RESOURCES                 Get Resources for RFC Destination                           .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I RETURN_RESOURCES              Return Resources for RFC Destination                        .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I SET_EXPIRATION_TIME_INBOUND   Validity of Resource (Inbound)                              .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I SET_EXPIRATION_TIME_OUTBOUND  Validity of Resource (Outbound)                             .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I SET_GATEWAY_QUOTA_INBOUND     Percentage Share of Gateway Resources (Inbound)             .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I SET_GATEWAY_QUOTA_OUTBOUND    Share of Outbound Gateway Resources (Percentage)            .
IF_BGRFC_DESTINATION_RESOURCES I UPDATE_RESOURCES              Refresh Current Resource State                              .
IF_BGRFC_EVENT_MANAGER         I REREGISTER                    Update Event Registration (Prevent Timeout)                 .
IF_BGRFC_EVENT_MANAGER         I UNREGISTER                    Deregister Event                                            .
IF_BGRFC_LOCK                  I RELEASE                       Deletes Lock                                                .
IF_BGRFC_SERVER                I GET_UNIT_ID                   Gets ID of Own Background RFC Unit                          .
IF_BGRFC_SERVER                I RETRY_UNIT                    Reset Current Unit (with Reason)                            .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I DELAY                         Sets Automatically Removed Lock                             .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I GET_FUNCTION_CALL_LIST        Gets List of All Function Module Calls                      .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I GET_FUNCTION_COUNT            Gets Number of Function Modules for Unit                    .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I IS_VALID                      Is unit valid in current application context?               .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I LOCK                          Sets Lock on Unit                                           .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I SEPARATE_FROM_UPDATE_TASK     Decouples Unit from Update                                  .
IF_BGRFC_UNIT                  I SET_FUNCTION_CALL_ORDER       Sets Order of Function Module Calls                         .
IF_BINREL_CA                   I ARC_RELOAD_LINK               Reload Relationship Record from Archive                     .
IF_BINREL_CA                   I CREATE_LINK                   Right Relationship Record                                   .
IF_BINREL_CA                   I DELETE_LINK                   Right Relationship Record                                   .
IF_BINREL_CA                   I READ_LINKS                    Read Relationships                                          .
IF_BINREL_CA                   I READ_LINK_AND_PROPERTY        Read Relationships                                          .
IF_BINREL_CL                   I CONNECT_TO_BROWSER            Prepare Data for IF_BROWSER_LINK                            .
IF_BINREL_CL                   I GET_LINK_DATA                 Delivers Relationship Record                                .
IF_BINREL_CL                   I GET_PARTNER                   Delivers Reference to Relationship Partner                  .
IF_BINREL_CL                   I WRITE_TO_ARCHIVE              Write Relationship Record to Archive                        .
IF_BINREL_PROP_ARCH            I ARCHIVE_GET                   Get Data with ARCHIVE_GET_TABLE from Archive                .
IF_BINREL_PROP_ARCH            I ARCHIVE_PUT                   Write Data with ARCHIVE_PUT_TABLE to Archive                .
IF_BINREL_PROP_ARCH            I GET_RECORD_STRUCTURE          Structure Used for Storage in Archive                       .
IF_BINREL_PROP_ARCH            I GET_TABLE_NAME                Tables Archived from Data                                   .
IF_BINREL_PROP_ARCH            I RELOAD                        Reload Data in the Database                                 .
IF_BINREL_PROP_CA              I DELETE_PROPERTY               Deletion of an Attribute                                    .
IF_BINREL_PROP_CA              I GET_DBTABLE                   Attribute Table Name                                        .
IF_BINREL_PROP_CA              I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Attribute                                              .
IF_BINREL_PROP_CA              I SET_OBJECTS_FROM_DATA         Generation of Attribute Instances from Pre-Selected Data    .
IF_BINREL_PROP_CA              I SET_PROPERTY                  Generate or Change an Attribute                             .
IF_BINREL_PROP_JOIN            I SELECT_FOR_ROLE_A             Relationships and Attributes for Objects in Role A          .
IF_BINREL_PROP_JOIN            I SELECT_FOR_ROLE_B             Relationships and Attributes for Object in Role B           .
IF_BIZC_AUTHORING_SERVICE      I GET_FIXED_RESTRICTIONS        Get all attributes and their fixed values                   .
IF_BIZC_AUTHORING_SERVICE      I GET_MATCH_ATTRIBUTES          Get all attributes, which can be used for filtered search   .
IF_BIZC_AUTHORING_SERVICE      I LIST                          List Contexts                                               .
IF_BIZC_AUTHORING_SERVICE      I LOOKUP                        Lookup the named context, return the represented objects    .
IF_BIZC_AUTHORING_SERVICE      I SEARCH                        Search for "named context"                                  .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I EXECUTE_ACTION                Executes an Action                                          .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_ACTION_DATA               Returns Adminsitration Data for a Task                      .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_CONTEXT_SUBSCREEN         Reads Subscreen Data of the Context UI                      .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_CONTEXT_UI                Reads Data from the Context UI                              .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns Description for a Task                              .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_DOCUMENTATION             Returns URL for a Documentation ID                          .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_STATUS_PER_OBJECT         Returns Status of Configuration of an Object                .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_TASKLIST                  Get the Task List for the Given Object                      .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I SAVE_CHANGES                  Saves Status of the Task List                               .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I SET_ACTION_DATA               Sets Administration Data for a Task                         .
IF_BIZC_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I SET_CONTEXT_UI                Sets the Data for the Context UI of a Task                  .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I ADD_DOCU_TO_OBJECT            Add Documentation to an Object                              .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I ADD_OBJECT_USAGE              Add Content Object for a Usage Type                         .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I COPY_OBJECT_USAGE             Copies an Object                                            .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I COPY_USAGE                    Copies a Usage Type                                         .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_CO_DESCRIPTION            Delivers Object Description                                 .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_CO_PERS_STATUS            Gets Persistence Status of an Object                        .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_CO_TECHNICAL_NAME         Gets Technical Name of an Object                            .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_DEPENDENCIES              Gets the Associated Software Components                     .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_DOCUMENTATION             Gets the Assigned Documentation                             .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_DOCUMENTATION_INFO        Returns Info Record for a Documentation Link                .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_OBJECT_CONFIG_INFO        Returns Configuration Info for an Object                    .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_OBJECT_GUID_BY_PROVIDER_IDGets the Object GUID for a Provider ID                      .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_OBJECT_HEADERS            Returns Flat Info Structure for Object Header               .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_OBJECT_USAGE_BY_STATUS    Gets Object GUIDs of the Usage Type Filtered by Status      .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_OBJECT_USAGE_INFO         Returns Flat Info Structure for an Object Usage             .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_PROVIDER_ID_BY_OBJECT_GUIDGets the Provider ID for an Object GUID                     .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I GET_USAGES_OF_OBJECT          Where-Used List for Object                                  .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I REMOVE_DOCU_FROM_OBJECT       Remove Documentation from an Object                         .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I REMOVE_OBJECT_USAGE           Remove Content Object from a Usage Type                     .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I REMOVE_USAGE                  Removes a Usage Type                                        .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I SET_OBJECT_CONFIG             Sets Configuration Info for an Object                       .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I UPDATE_DOCU                   Change Documentation                                        .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I UPDATE_OBJECT                 Update Content Object                                       .
IF_BIZC_CONTENT_MANAGER        I UPDATE_OBJECT_USAGE           Update Usage of a Content Object                            .
IF_BIZC_CONTEXT_UI             I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Gets data for calling a subscreen                           .
IF_BIZC_CONTEXT_UI             I GET_UI_DATA                   Gets the preconfigured context from the UI                  .
IF_BIZC_CONTEXT_UI             I GET_UI_TECHNOLOGY             Gets the used UI technology                                 .
IF_BIZC_CONTEXT_UI             I SET_UI_DATA                   Transfers current data to the UI                            .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_APPL_SERVERS_FROM_PRODUCT Returns Application Server for a Product                    .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_AUTHORING_PROXY           Proxy for Authoring API for Content Providers               .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_CALLING_SYSTEM_DATA       Determines SYSID and Client of the Calling System           .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_CLIENT_FROM_PRODUCT       Determines Assigned Client for a Product                    .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_DESTINATION_TO_PRODUCT    Determines Destination for the System of a Product          .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_JAVA_SERVER_FROM_PRODUCT  Determines Server and Port of the Java Server               .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_LOGON_GROUPS_FROM_PRODUCT Determines the Logon Groups from SLD for a Product          .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_LOGSYS_FROM_PRODUCT       Determines Logical System for a Product                     .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_MSG_SERVER_FROM_PRODUCT   Determines Assigned Message Server for a Product            .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_SYSTEM_FROM_PRODUCT       Determines Assigned System for a Product                    .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I GET_SYS_NUMBER_FROM_PRODUCT   Determines Assigned System Number for a Product             .
IF_BIZC_DESTINATION_INTERFACE  I SYNCHRONIZE                   Performs a New Synchronization of the Destinations          .
IF_BIZC_DOCUMENT               I RESET                         called after update to reset buffered data                  .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I COMMIT                        Saves all new or modified objects                           .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I COPY_OBJECTS                  Copies Content objects between and within usages            .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I DELETE_OBJECTS                Deletes Objects                                             .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I DELETE_USAGE                  Deletes an entire usage                                     .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I EXPORT_USAGE                  Exports alle data as a usage as an XML string               .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I GET_OBJECT_CONFIG_STATUS      Determines Current Configuration Status of an Object        .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I GET_SELECTED_OBJECTS          Objects searched for on selection screen                    .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I IMPORT_USAGE                  Imports all data as a usage as an XML string                .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I LANGUAGE_UPDATE               Reads Language-Specific Texts of an Object                  .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I READ_OBJECTS                  All objects of a usage                                      .
IF_BIZC_FW_BIZC_API            I ROLLBACK                      Resets changed objects and deletes new objects              .
IF_BIZC_FW_UI                  I SHOW_CONFIG_SCREEN            User Interface for Configuring Content Objects              .
IF_BIZC_FW_UI                  I SHOW_DETAIL_SCREEN            Display Detailed Data About a Content Object                .
IF_BIZC_FW_UI                  I SHOW_SELECTION_SCREEN         Display Selection Screen (Search, Browse)                   .
IF_BIZC_FW_UI                  I SHOW_TEMPLATE_SCREEN          Template Editor                                             .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I GET_ID                        Determine ID / Name of Context                              .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I GET_TECHNICAL_NAME            Read Technical Name                                         .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I GET_TEXT                      Determine Long Text (Description)                           .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I IS_CONTENT_OBJECT             Is object a Content object?                                 .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I IS_CONTEXT                    Is object a context?                                        .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I SET_ID                        Save ID / Name of Context                                   .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I SET_TECHNICAL_NAME            Set Technical Name                                          .
IF_BIZC_NAMED_CONTEXT          I SET_TEXT                      Save Long Text (Description)                                .
IF_BIZC_OPERATION              I CHECK_STATUS                  Checks the Status of an Operation                           .
IF_BIZC_OPERATION              I EXECUTE                       Executes the Operation                                      .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I GET_AGGREGATED_CONFIG         Returns aggregate configuration for a template              .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I GET_EXCLUDED_TASKS            Gets the excluded tasks from the preconfigured context      .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Gets data for calling a subscreen                           .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I GET_UI_DATA                   Gets the preconfigured context from the UI                  .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I GET_UI_TECHNOLOGY             Gets the used UI technology                                 .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I SET_EXCLUDED_TASKS            Extends the preconfigured context by excluded tasks         .
IF_BIZC_PRECONFIGURATION       I SET_UI_DATA                   Transfers the current data to the UI                        .
IF_BIZC_PRODUCT_INTERFACE      I GET_AVAILABLE_PRODUCTS        Returns the Products that are Currently Available           .
IF_BIZC_PRODUCT_INTERFACE      I GET_INSTALLED_PRODUCTS        Returns All Installations of a Product with Description     .
IF_BIZC_PRODUCT_INTERFACE      I GET_PRODUCT_FROM_OBJECT       Returns the Product Assigned to an Object                   .
IF_BIZC_PRODUCT_INTERFACE      I IS_SOFTWARE_COMP_INSTALLED    Checks Whether Software Component Exists in a Product       .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I ADD_OBJECTS                   Assigns Additional Objects to the Task                      .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete the Object Assignment                                .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_CREATION_INFO             Returns Generation Data                                     .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_INDEX                     Returns Index of the Task                                   .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_INDEX_GUID                Returns GUID of the Index                                   .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_LAST_MODIFIED_INFO        Returns Data About Last Change                              .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_OBJECTS                   Returns Objects                                             .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_STATUS                    Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_TASK_NAME                 Returns Technical Name of the Task                          .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I GET_USAGE                     Returns Object Usage                                        .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I SET_LAST_MODIFIED_INFO        Sets the Data for Last Change                               .
IF_BIZC_TASK                   I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status                                             .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I CREATE_TASK                   Generates a Task                                            .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I DELETE_TASK                   Deletes a Task                                              .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I GET_TASK                      Returns a Task                                              .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I GET_TASKS_FOR_OBJECT          Returns All Tasks of an Object                              .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I GET_TASKS_FOR_USAGE           Returns All Tasks of a Usage                                .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I GET_TASK_FOR_XML_NODE         Returns a Task for a for an XML Node                        .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_PERSISTENCY   I SAVE_CHANGES                  Saves the Buffered Changes                                  .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_SERVICE       I CONFIRM_ACTION                Confirms an Action                                          .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_SERVICE       I EXECUTE_ACTION                Executes an Action                                          .
IF_BIZC_TASKLIST_SERVICE       I GET_ACTION_DATA               Returns Current Data for an Action                          .
IF_BMA_APPLICATION             I ANNOTATE                      Create Note in Dialog                                       .
IF_BMA_APPLICATION             I DELEGATE                      Delegate Migration Task in Dialog                           .
IF_BMA_APPLICATION             I OKCODE_HANDLER                OK Code Processing in Transaction                           .
IF_BMA_APPLICATION             I SET_STATUS                    Change Status of Migration Task in Dialog                   .
IF_BMA_APPLICATION             I SHOW_DOCU                     Display Migration Documentation                             .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I ADD_TRANSCRIPT                Add One or More Text Lines to Log                           .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I GET_DETAIL                    Get More Data from Main Program                             .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I GET_MIGITEM_ID                Get Unique Work Item ID                                     .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I GET_TRANSCRIPT                Get Log Information                                         .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I IS_READONLY                   Gets read only status                                       .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I SET_RESPONSIBLE               Delegate Responsibility for Migration Task                  .
IF_BMA_BROWSER_CONTEXT         I SET_STATUS                    Set Status Flag in Worklist                                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I ACTIVATE_AUTOCLEANUP          Activates Automatic Removal of Deleted Entities             .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I ADD                           Adds a BO to the Collection                                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I ADD_COLLECTION                Adds Another Collection to the Collection                   .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I CLEAR                         Deletes the Entire Collection                               .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I FIND                          Search for a Business Object in the Collection              .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_COPY                      Returns a Copy of the Collection                            .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_CURRENT                   Returns the Current Focus Business Object of the Collection .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_CURRENT_INDEX             Returns the Index for Current Focus Bus.Objs of Collection  .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_FIRST                     Returns the First Business Object of the Collection         .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_ITERATOR                  Returns an Iterator Instance for the BO of the Collection   .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_LAST                      Returns the Last Business Object of the Collection          .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_MARKED                    Returns the Selected Business Objects                       .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_MARKED_INDICES            Returns a Table of Indexes of the Selected Business Objects .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_NEXT                      Returns the Next Business Object of the Collection          .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns the Previous Business Object of the Collection      .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I MARK                          Selects a Business Object in the Collection                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I MARK_ALL                      Selects all Business Objects in the Collection              .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I PUBLISH_CURRENT               Publicizes the Current Focus Element via Event FOCUS_CHANGED.
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I REMOVE                        Deletes a Business Object from the Collection               .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I SET_MULTI_SELECT              Activates Multiselect Mode for Collection                   .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I SIZE                          Returns the Number of Business Objects in the Collection    .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I SORT                          Sort Collection By                                          .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I UNMARK                        Selects a Business Object in the Collection                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL                  I UNMARK_ALL                    Deselects all Business Objects in the Collection            .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I DELETE_FILTER                 Delete Filter                                               .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I FILTER_BY_PROPERTY            Filter Collection According to Value Specified              .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I FIND_BY_PROPERTY              Searches for BO with a Specific Value for a Given Attribute .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_BY_INDEX                  Returns the Business Object for a Given Index               .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_CURRENT                   Delivers the Current Focus Business Object Instance         .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_CURRENT_INDEX             Returns the Index of the Current Focus Business Object      .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_FIRST                     Returns the First Business Object Instance                  .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_LAST                      Returns the Last Business Object Instance                   .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_NEXT                      Returns the Next Business Object Instance                   .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns the Previous Business Object Instance               .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_ITERATOR         I SIZE                          Current Number of Entries (Taking Filter Into Account)      .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I GET_MARKED                    Returns the Selected Business Objects                       .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I GET_MARKED_INDICES            Returns a Table of Indexes of the Selected Business Objects .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I MARK                          Selects a Business Object in the Collection                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I MARK_ALL                      Selects all Business Objects in the Collection              .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I UNMARK                        Selects a Business Object in the Collection                 .
IF_BOL_BO_COL_MULTI_SEL        I UNMARK_ALL                    Deselects all Business Objects in the Collection            .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I GET_PROPERTIES                Returns a Structure with All Business Object Attributes     .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I GET_PROPERTY                  Returns a Reference to an Attribute                         .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I GET_PROPERTY_AS_STRING        Returns an Attribute Converted to a String                  .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I GET_PROPERTY_AS_VALUE         Returns an Attribute                                        .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I IS_PROPERTY_READONLY          Checks Whether an Attribute is Read-Only                    .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I SET_PROPERTIES                Set All Business Object Attributes Using a Structure        .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets an Attribute                                           .
IF_BOL_BO_PROPERTY_ACCESS      I SET_PROPERTY_AS_STRING        Sets an Attribute with Conversion from String               .
IF_BOL_COL_SORTING             I IS_A_GREATER_B                Checks whether Element A is Greater than Element B          .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I ADD                           Adds an Entity to Collection                                .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I ADD_COLLECTION                Adds Another Collection to the Collection                   .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I FIND                          Search for Entity in Collection                             .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_COPY                      Returns a Copy of the Collection                            .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_CURRENT                   Returns the Current Focus Entity of the Collection          .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_FIRST                     Returns the First Entity of the Collection                  .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_ITERATOR                  Returns the Instance of a Local Iterator                    .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_LAST                      Returns the Last Entity of the Collection                   .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_NEXT                      Returns the Next Entity of the Collection                   .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns the Previous Entity of the Collection               .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I REMOVE                        Remove an Entity from Collection                            .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I SIZE                          Returns Number of Enities in the Collection                 .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL              I SORT                          Sort Collection By                                          .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I DELETE_FILTER                 Delete Filter                                               .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I FILTER_BY_PROPERTY            Filter Collection According to Value Specified              .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I FIND_BY_PROPERTY              Searches for BO with a Specific Value for a Given Attribute .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_BY_INDEX                  Returns the Business Object for a Given Index               .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_CURRENT                   Returns Current Focus Entity in List                        .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_CURRENT_INDEX             Returns the Index of the Current Focus Business Object      .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_FIRST                     Returns First Entity in List                                .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_LAST                      Returns Last Entity in List                                 .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Entity in List                                 .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns Previous Entity in List                             .
IF_BOL_ENTITY_COL_ITERATOR     I SIZE                          Current Number of Entries (Taking Filter Into Account)      .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I CHECK_SAVE_NEEDED             Checks Whether Data Has to Be Saved                         .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I CHECK_SAVE_POSSIBLE           Checks Whether Data Can Be Saved                            .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I COMMIT                        Commit                                                      .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I GET_ID                        Returns Context ID                                          .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I GET_NAME                      Returns Context Name                                        .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I REVERT                        Discard Changes                                             .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I ROLLBACK                      Rollback                                                    .
IF_BOL_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT     I SAVE                          Save Objects in Transaction                                 .
IF_BOM_MM                      I GET_DATA                      Deliver SC Components                                       .
IF_BOM_MM                      I SET_DATA                      Set SC Components/Additional Data                           .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I CALL_CHECK                    Execute Checks                                              .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I GET_INFOS                     Get Information on Caller                                   .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I RESET_FIELD_COLOR             Reset Color                                                 .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I SEND_TREE_EVENT               Sends an Event to Caller                                    .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I SEND_USER_COMMAND             Sends a Message with UserCommand to Caller                  .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I SET_CURSOR_TO                 Position Cursor                                             .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I SET_FIELD                     Set Field                                                   .
IF_BORGR_WIZARD                I SET_FIELD_COLOR               Select a Field                                              .
IF_BOR_OBJECT_PPF              I GET_BOR_OBJECT                Read BOR Object Reference of Application                    .
IF_BOSPS_CE_TREE_MODIFIER      I CHANGE_ADD_NODE_DATA          Change Add Node data of ALV Tree                            .
IF_BOSPS_CE_TREE_MODIFIER      I NODE_ADDED                    Node Added (Event)                                          .
IF_BP_DB_TRANSACTION           I SAVE_DB                       Save entry to database table                                .
IF_BP_DB_TRANSACTION           I UPDATE_DB                     Update entry to database table                              .
IF_BP_JOB_CHECK                I IS_DEFINED                    Check whether a job is properly defined                     .
IF_BP_JOB_CHECK                I SET_COMPLETED                 Set the job definition to complete                          .
IF_BP_JOB_ENGINE               I GENERATE_JOB_COUNT            Generate job count                                          .
IF_BP_JOB_ENGINE               I PLAN_JOB                      Plan job (without starting condition)                       .
IF_BP_JOB_ENGINE               I PLAN_JOB_STEP                 Schedule one step for the job                               .
IF_BP_JOB_ENGINE               I RELEASE_JOB                   Attach start condition to the job                           .
IF_BP_JOB_ENGINE               I START_IMMEDIATELY             Start the job immediately                                   .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_ABAP_JOB                 Create an instance of CL_BP_ABAP_JOB class                  .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_ABAP_JOB_BY_ID           Create an instance of cl_bp_abap_job by guid                .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_EXTCMD_JOB               Create an instance of cl_bp_extcmd_job class                .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_EXTCMD_JOB_BY_ID         Create an instance of cl_bp_extcmd_job by guid              .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_EXTPRG_JOB               Create an instance of cl_bp_extprg_job class                .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_EXTPRG_JOB_BY_ID         Create an instance of cl_bp_extprg_job by guid              .
IF_BP_JOB_FACTORY              I MAKE_PERIODIC_JOB             Create an instance of periodic job                          .
IF_BP_JOB_PERIODICITY          I ATTACH_PERIODICITY            Attach periodicity to a job                                 .
IF_BP_JOB_PERIODICITY          I CHECK_PERIODICITY             Check validation of periodicity                             .
IF_BP_JOB_PERIODICITY          I GET_PERIODICITY               Get periodicity to a job                                    .
IF_BP_JOB_PERIODICITY          I RELEASE_PERIODIC_JOB          Release periodic job                                        .
IF_BP_JOB_PERIODICITY          I SET_PERIODICITY               Set periodicity to a job                                    .
IF_BP_JOB_TMPL_FACTORY         I MAKE_ABAP_JOB                 Create an instance of CL_BP_ABAP_JOB_TMPL                   .
IF_BP_JOB_TMPL_FACTORY         I MAKE_EXTCMD_JOB               Create an instance of CL_BP_EXTCMD_JOB_TMPL                 .
IF_BP_JOB_TMPL_FACTORY         I MAKE_EXTPRG_JOB               Create an instance of CL_BP_EXTPRG_JOB_TMPL                 .
IF_BP_TRIGGER_FACTORY          I MAKE_DATE_TRIGGER             Creates a date/time trigger                                 .
IF_BP_TRIGGER_FACTORY          I MAKE_EVENT_TRIGGER            Creates an event trigger                                    .
IF_BP_TRIGGER_FACTORY          I MAKE_ONWORKDAY_TRIGGER        Creates a on-workday trigger                                .
IF_BP_TRIGGER_FACTORY          I MAKE_OPMODE_TRIGGER           Creates an opmode trigger                                   .
IF_BP_TRIGGER_TMPL_FACTORY     I MAKE_DATE_TRIGGER             builds a date/time trigger template when used with a factory.
IF_BP_TRIGGER_TMPL_FACTORY     I MAKE_EVENT_TRIGGER            builds an event trigger template when used with a factory   .
IF_BRF_EVENT_BCFL00            I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Context Parameter                                      .
IF_BRF_EVENT_FLIGHT            I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Context Parameter                                      .
IF_BRF_EVENT_ICL               I SET_ACTUAL                    Sets Specific Additional Information                        .
IF_BRF_EVENT_ICL               I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Specific Additional Information (incl. Subclaims)      .
IF_BRF_EVENT_ICLE              I SET_ACTUAL                    Sets Context Information                                    .
IF_BROWSER_LINK                I DISPLAY                       Relationship Service Specific Method                        .
IF_BROWSER_LINK                I FIND                          Search Relationship in Int. Table                           .
IF_BROWSER_LINK                I GET_ATTR_ICON                 Returns the Icon Display of an Attribute                    .
IF_BROWSER_LINK                I GET_ATTR_TEXT                 Returns the Test Display of an Attribute                    .
IF_BRR_RULE_METADATA           I GET_HEADER_DATA               Read DB Header Entry Set During Loading                     .
IF_BRR_RULE_METADATA           I GET_RULE_TYPE                 'C' - Condition, 'R'-Rule, 'S'-Rule System                  .
IF_BRR_RULE_METADATA           I SET_HEADER_DATA               Sets Data of Current DB Header Entry                        .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_NAME          Returns the Name of the Corresponding BSP Application       .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_NAMESPACE     Returns the Namespace of the Corresponding BSP Application  .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_START_PAGE    Returns the Start Page of the Corresponding BSP Application .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_THEME         Returns the Subject of the Corresponding BSP Application    .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_URL           Returns the URL for the BSP Application                     .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_REQUEST                   Returns the Current HTTP Request Object                     .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_RESPONSE                  Returns the Current HTTP Response Object                    .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_RUNTIME                   Returns the Associated Runtime Object                       .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I GET_TIMEOUT                   Returns the Current Timeout for this BSP Application        .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I IS_STATEFUL                   Returns Whether the BSP Application is Stateful (=0/1)      .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I SET_STATEFUL                  Sets this BSP Application in Stateful Processing            .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I SET_STATELESS                 Sets this BSP Application in Stateless Processing           .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION             I SET_TIMEOUT                   Sets the Timeout for this BSP Application (If Stateful)     .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION_EVENTS      I ON_REQUEST                    Called for every incoming HTTP request                      .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION_EVENTS      I ON_RESPONSE                   Called for every outgoing HTTP response                     .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION_EVENTS      I ON_START                      Called if the application is started                        .
IF_BSP_APPLICATION_EVENTS      I ON_STOP                       Called if the application is ended                          .
IF_BSP_BEE                     I RENDER                        Write BEE to (Page Context) Out Writer                      .
IF_BSP_BEE                     I RENDER_TO_STRING              Write BEE in String                                         .
IF_BSP_COMPONENT               I FILL_VALUES                   Process or Dispatch: Handle Values                          .
IF_BSP_COMPONENT               I FINISH_INPUT_PROCESSING       Process or Dispatch: End of Input Processing                .
IF_BSP_COMPONENT               I HANDLE_EVENT                  Process or Dispatch: Handle Event                           .
IF_BSP_CONTROLLER              I FILL_VALUES                   Process or Dispatch: Handle Values                          .
IF_BSP_CONTROLLER              I FINISH_INPUT_PROCESSING       Process or Dispatch: End of Input Processing                .
IF_BSP_CONTROLLER              I HANDLE_EVENT                  Process or Dispatch: Handle Event                           .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I DO_AT_BEGINNING               Before an Element                                           .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I DO_AT_END                     After an Element                                            .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I INITIALIZE                    Call at Start of New Layout                                 .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I IS_ACTIVE                     Active for This Page?                                       .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I NAVIGATION_UPDATE             Redirect URL/Change Page                                    .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I PAGE_END                      Call at End of a Page (for Rendering)                       .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I PAGE_START                    Call at Start of a Page                                     .
IF_BSP_DELTA_HANDLER           I PREAMBLE                      Should a First "frame" be Rendered?                         .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I CHANGE_FOCUS                  Change Focus                                                .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I CHECK_ACTIVE_TOOLBAR          Read Active Pushbuttons                                     .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I FILL_DROPDOWN_LISTBOX         Read Dropdown Listbox Values                                .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I FREE_BUFFER                   Resets Buffer                                               .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I GET_FOCUS_OBJECT_KEY          Returns the Last Focus as Object Key                        .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I MODIFY_DATA                   Copies Changed Dated                                        .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I PROCESS_EVENT                 Execution of a UI Event                                     .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I READ_DATA                     Reads Assigned Differentiation Keys                         .
IF_BSP_DIFF_KEY_ADAPTER        I READ_FOCUS_OBJECT             Reads the Diffentiation Key for Focus                       .
IF_BSP_DISPATCHER              I REGISTER                      Subcomponent Registration                                   .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I COMPILE_TIME_IS_VALID         Compile Time Query Whether all Attributes are OK            .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I DO_AT_BEGINNING               Call at Beginning of a BSP Element                          .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I DO_AT_END                     Call at End of a BSP Element                                .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I DO_AT_ITERATION               Call at End of a BSP Element Content                        .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I DO_SET_DATA                   Inner BSP Element with DATA Property                        .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I GET_CLASS_NAMED_PARENT        Search Parent of Specific Class Type                        .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I GET_DIRECT_PARENT             Get Direct Parent BSP Element                               .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I GET_ELEMENT_NAMED_PARENT      Find Parent with Specific Name                              .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I RAISE_ERROR                   Raise CX_BSP_ELEMENT_EXCEPTION                              .
IF_BSP_ELEMENT                 I RUNTIME_IS_VALID              Runtime Query (CX_BSP_ELEMENT_EXCEPTION)                    .
IF_BSP_HAP_VAL_DET             I VALUE_DETERMINATION_UI        Value Determination in User Interface                       .
IF_BSP_METADATA                I GET_ABAP_TYPE                 ABAP Type (d, t, ...)                                       .
IF_BSP_METADATA                I GET_LABEL                     Field Label                                                 .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I GET_CONVERSION_EXIT           Returns the Name of the Conversion Exit                     .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I GET_DISPLAY_LENGTH            Display Length/Output Length                                .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I GET_LENGTH                    Length                                                      .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I GET_VALUELIST                 Returns a List With Possible Values                         .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I HAS_VALUE_HELP                Value Help Supported?                                       .
IF_BSP_METADATA_SIMPLE         I UPPERCASE_ONLY                Only Supports Capitals                                      .
IF_BSP_METADATA_STRUCT         I DESCRIBE_COMPONENT_BY_INDEX   Returns the Metadata for a Structure Component (Index)      .
IF_BSP_METADATA_STRUCT         I DESCRIBE_COMPONENT_BY_NAME    Returns the Metadata for a Structure Component (Name)       .
IF_BSP_METADATA_STRUCT         I GET_COMPONENT_NAMES           Returns the Name of all Components in the Structure         .
IF_BSP_METADATA_STRUCT         I NUM_COMPONENTS                Returns the Number of Structure Components in the Structure .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I ADD_TO_CHECK_TABLE            Inserts the control ID into the check table                 .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I GET_BINDING_INTERFACE         Returns a Reference to the Binding Interface                .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I GET_ERRORS                    Inserts the Assignment Error to the Specified Messages      .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I INIT                          Initialization Method for all Model Implementations         .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I INSTANTIATE                   Filling the Model from the Request                          .
IF_BSP_MODEL                   I RESET_ERRORS                  Inserts the Assignment Error to the Specified Messages      .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I BUILD_ATTRIBUTE_PATH          Returns the Binding Path of an Attribute                    .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns the Value of an Attribute in String Representation  .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DATA_REF        Returns an Attribute Reference                              .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I GET_ATTRIBUTE_METADATA        Returns the Metadata of an Attribute                        .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NAME            Returns the (HTML) Name of an Attribute                     .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I GET_ID                        Returns the ID of the Model                                 .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I IS_ATTRIBUTE_VALID            Queries Attribute Valid?                                    .
IF_BSP_MODEL_BINDING           I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets an Attribute According to String Representation        .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_M_S_XYZ                  Template: Metadata Getter for Structure Attributes          .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_M_T_XYZ                  Template: Metadata Getter for Table Attributes              .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_M_XYZ                    Template: Metadata Getter for Simple Attribute              .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_S_XYZ                    Template: Getter for Structure Fields/Structure Attributes  .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_T_XYZ                    Template: Getter for Table Fields/Table Attributes          .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _GET_XYZ                      Template: Getter for Individual Field/Simple Attribute      .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _SET_S_XYZ                    Template: Setter for Structure Fields/Structure Attributes  .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _SET_T_XYZ                    Template: Setter for Table Fields/Table Attributes          .
IF_BSP_MODEL_SETTER_GETTER     I _SET_XYZ                      Template: Setter for Individual Fields/Simple Attribute     .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I CONVERT_FROM_STRING           Sets a Data Reference According to String Representation    .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I CONVERT_TO_STRING             Returns the Formatted String Representation                 .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I DISASSEMBLE_PATH              Path Breakdown of an Attribute                              .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I GET_ATTRIBUTE_AS_REF          Returns the Reference to the Requested Attribute            .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I IS_BINDING_EXPRESSION         Returns TRUE if Binding Expression                          .
IF_BSP_MODEL_UTIL              I SPLIT_BINDING_EXPRESSION      Returns the Name of the Model Attribute and the Att. Path   .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I CALL_APPLICATION              Calls an external application and passes a return URL       .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I ENCODE_PARAMETERS             Controls parameter pass coded (default) or uncoded          .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I EXIT                          Exits the running application                               .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I GET_PARAMETER                 Gets the parameter from the parameters list                 .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I GOTO_PAGE                     Navigates to the specified page (redirect)                  .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I GOTO_PAGE_CS                  Navigates to the specified page (redirect)                  .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I HAS_PARAMETERS                Returns bspr_yes if this object contains parameters         .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I NEXT_PAGE                     Follows the specified page exit to the next page            .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I RESPONSE_COMPLETE             Indicates that full HTTP response is available              .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I SET_PARAMETER                 Adds the parameter to the parameters passed to the next page.
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I USE_ABSOLUTE_URL              Use absolute URLs instead of relative URLs                  .
IF_BSP_NAVIGATION              I USE_AUTO_SUBMIT_FORM          Use                                                         .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I COMPARE_TO_BSP_PAGE           Compare with Other BSP Page                                 .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION               Returns the Associated Application Object                   .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION_NAME          Returns the Name of the BSP Application                     .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION_NAMESPACE     Returns the Namespace of the BSP Application                .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION_START_PAGE    Returns the Name of the Start Page of the BSP Application   .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION_THEME         Returns the Subject of the BSP Application                  .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_APPLICATION_URL           Returns the URL to the BSP Application                      .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Supplies the Given Page Attribute                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_DELTA_HANDLER             Returns the Associated Delta Handling Object                .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_LIFETIME                  Supplies the Lifetime of This Page (see lifetime_...)       .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_OUT                       Fetches the Current Writer                                  .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_PAGE_CONTEXT              Returns the Associated Page Context Object                  .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_PAGE_NAME                 Returns the Name of the Page                                .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_PAGE_URL                  Supplies the URL of the Page                                .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_REQUEST                   Returns the Request Object                                  .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_RESPONSE                  Returns the Response Object                                 .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I GET_RUNTIME                   Returns the Associated Runtime Object                       .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I OTR_TRIM                      Returns the Language-Dependent Text for an OTR Alias        .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I SERIALIZE                     Serializes the Content of the Page in a String              .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets the Specified Page Attribute                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I SET_CACHING                   Sets Caching Values                                         .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I SET_LIFETIME                  Sets the Lifetime of this Page (see lifetime_...)           .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I SET_MIME_TYPE                 Sets MIME Type of Page                                      .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I TO_STRING                     Creates a Formatting String                                 .
IF_BSP_PAGE                    I WRITE                         Writes a Formatted String to the Output                     .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I DELTA_HANDLING_BEGIN          HTML Demarcation Boundary                                   .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I DELTA_HANDLING_END            HTML Demarcation Boundary                                   .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I ELEMENT_AT_TOP_OF_STACK       List of All Elements on the Stack                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I ELEMENT_PROCESS               Processes a BSP Element                                     .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I ELEMENT_STACK_DUMP            List of All Elements on the Stack                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_ABSOLUTE_ID               Returns the Absolute ID incl. Page ID (and Model ID)        .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_MODEL                     Returns a Reference to the Binding Interface                .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_NAVIGATION                Nagivation Object                                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_OUT                       Current Writer                                              .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_PAGE                      BSP Page Object                                             .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_PAGE_MIME_TYPE            Returns the Mime Type of the Page                           .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_REQUEST                   Request Object                                              .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_RESPONSE                  Reponse Object                                              .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I GET_RUNTIME                   Runtime Object                                              .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I POP_WRITER                    Old IF_BSP_WRITER On Stack                                  .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I PUSH_WRITER                   New IF_BSP_WRITER (On Stack)                                .
IF_BSP_PAGE_CONTEXT            I RELEASE                       "destructor" called from BSPFactory                         .
IF_BSP_PERSIST_DATA            I INSTANTIATE                   Creates Data from a String Representation                   .
IF_BSP_PERSIST_DATA            I SERIALIZE                     Creates String Representation of Data to Persist            .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I CONSTRUCT_BSP_URL             Constructs a URL for a BSP Application or Page              .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_DOMAIN_RELAX_SCRIPT       Returns JavaScript for Relax Domain                         .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_EXTERNAL_STYLESHEET       Returns the URL of the External Stylesheet, Otherwise Empty .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_EXTERNAL_THEME_ROOT       Returns the Root Path for External Theme Objects            .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_OTR_TEXT                  Returns the OTR Text in the Current Language for Alias      .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_URL                       Returns the URL of the Current Page                         .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_URL_NEW_SESSION           Returns a URL for a BSP Page in a New Session               .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_URL_SAME_SESSION          Returns a URL for a BSP Page in the Same Session            .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I GET_URL_STATELESS             Returns a URL for a Stateless BSP Page                      .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I REGISTER_COMPONENT            Subcomponent Registration                                   .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I SET_EXTERNAL_THEME_ROOT       Set Root Path to External Theme Object for Request Only     .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I SET_RIGHT_TO_LEFT             Set HTML "Right To Left"                                    .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I WITH_ACCESSIBILITY            Confirms whether the Accessibility Function is On           .
IF_BSP_RUNTIME                 I WITH_RIGHT_TO_LEFT            HTML "Right To Left"                                        .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_DAY_COLLECTION            Returns the Name and Short Description of all Days          .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_FIELD_LABEL               Returns the Label (Field ID) for a Data Object              .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_HISTORY_ID                Returns a Global History ID                                 .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_LOCAL_HISTORY_ID          Returns a history ID local in application                   .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_MONTH_COLLECTION          Returns the Name and Short ID of all Months                 .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_QUICKINFO                 Returns the Quick Info (Short Description) for a Data Object.
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_SIMPLE_HELPVALUES         Returns the List of Values from a Simple Search Help        .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_SIMPLE_HELPVALUES2        Returns the List of Values from a Simple Search Help        .
IF_BSP_SERVICES                I GET_TABL_INFO                 Returns the Type Information and Texts for a Table          .
IF_BSP_SESSMAN                 I HEADER_SCRIPT                 Include with Workplace-Specific Entries                     .
IF_BSP_SESSMAN                 I HEADER_SCRIPT_LIGHT           Include with Domain Relax Entries                           .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I CHECK_IS_NEW_CNODE_ATTR_VALID Checks Whether a New Attribute Name is Possible             .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I CHECK_IS_TREE_CNODE           Checks Whether a Context Node Represents a Tree Structure   .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_APPLICATION_CLASS         Returns the Application Class                               .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_APPLICATION_NAME          Returns the Name of the BSP Application                     .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_APPL_CNTR_IMPLCLASS       Provides the Implementation Class of the Appl. Controller   .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_COMPONENT_IMPLCLASS       Returns Implementation Class of the Component Controller    .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_CONTEXT_NODES             Provides the Context Node of a Context                      .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_CONTEXT_NODE_ATTR         Provides the Attributes of a Context Node                   .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_CONTROLLER_IMPLCLASS      Provides the Implementation Class of a Controller           .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_CUSTOM_CONTROLLERS        Provides a List of Custom Controllers for the Application   .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_EVENT_HANDLERS            Provides the Context Class of a Controller                  .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_FIRST_LEVEL_MIMES         Provides the Assigned MIME Objects from the First Level     .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_FLOW_LOGIC_PAGES          Returns the Pages with Flow Logic                           .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_INBOUND_PLUGS             Provides the Context Class of a Controller                  .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_MISSED_GET_I_METHODS      Provides the List of Missing GET_I_ Methods                 .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_OUTBOUND_PLUGS            Provides the Context Class of a Controller                  .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_PAGE_FRAGMENTS            Provides Page Fragments                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_ROOT_CONTEXT_NODES        Provides the Context Node of a Context                      .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_RUNTIME_CONTEXT           Provides the Context Class of a Controller (Runtime Type)   .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_START_URL                 Provides the URL of the Start Page                          .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_SUBCONTEXT_NODES          Provides the Context Node of a Context                      .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_TREE_CHILD_NODES          Provides the Lower-Level Node of a Tree Node                .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_TREE_ROOT_NODES           Provides the Root Node of a Tree                            .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_TYPED_CONTEXT             Provides the Context Class of a Controller(Design Time Type).
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_VIEWS                     Provides All Views of the Application                       .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_VIEW_CONTROLLERS          Provides a List of the View Controllers of the Application  .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_VIEW_IMPLCLASS            Provides the Implementation Class of a View Controller      .
IF_BSP_WD_APPL_MODEL           I GET_WINDOWS                   Provides All Windows of the Application/Components          .
IF_BSP_WD_EXT_PROPERTY_ACCESS  I GET_MODEL_NODE                Delivers Reference of Model Node                            .
IF_BSP_WD_GENINFO              I GET_GENINFO                   Query Implementing Class                                    .
IF_BSP_WD_GENINFO              I GET_GENINFO_ADJUST            Query Implementing Class                                    .
IF_BSP_WD_GENINFO              I GET_GENINFO_EXT               Query Implementing Class                                    .
IF_BSP_WD_GEN_ABAP_STATEMENT   I APPEND                        Attach New Statement                                        .
IF_BSP_WD_GEN_ABAP_STATEMENT   I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Statement                                      .
IF_BSP_WD_GEN_ABAP_STATEMENT   I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns Previous Statement                                  .
IF_BSP_WD_GEN_ABAP_STATEMENT   I GET_SOURCE                    Returns Statement Source Text                               .
IF_BSP_WD_GEN_ABAP_STATEMENT   I SET_SOURCE                    Set Source Text for Statement                               .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISP I GET_HISTORY                   Returns the current history for display                     .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISP I GO_BACK                       Request backwards navigation                                .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISP I GO_FORWARD                    Request forward navigation                                  .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISP I GO_STATE                      Request a qualified state                                   .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISP I RESET_HISTORY                 Request to reset the complete history                       .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE        I STATE_DELETE_ALL              Delete all stored states                                    .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE        I STATE_RESTORE                 Restore current state                                       .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE        I STATE_STORE                   Store current state                                         .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_CONT   I ADD_ITEM                      Add any named value                                         .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_CONT   I GET_ITEM                      Get any named value                                         .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_CONT   I GET_ITEM_LIST                 Get a list of all element names                             .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_CONT   I REMOVE_ALL_ITEMS              Remove all named values                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_CONT   I REMOVE_ITEM                   Remove any named value                                      .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_DESCR  I GET_MAIN_ENTITY               Returns the Main/Root entity of the View(set)               .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_DESCR  I GET_STATE_DESCRIPTION         Return a user-friendly string describing the state          .
IF_BSP_WD_HISTORY_STATE_DESCR  I IS_RESTORABLE                 Returns TRUE if viewset is restorable                       .
IF_BSP_WD_LOGGING              I ADD                           Add Log Entry                                               .
IF_BSP_WD_NAVIGATION           I ERROR_NAVIGATE                Navigation with Errors                                      .
IF_BSP_WD_NAVIGATION           I NAVIGATE                      Navigation Call                                             .
IF_BSP_WD_STATE_CONTEXT        I GET_MESSAGE_FILTER            Returns a Filter for the Global Message Log                 .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I COLLAPS_NODE                  Collapse Node                                               .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I EXPAND_NODE                   Expand Node                                                 .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I GET_CHILDREN                  Delivers a List of All Children                             .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I GET_ICON                      Delivers Icon for Node                                      .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I GET_ICON_TOOLTIP              Delivers Tooltip for the Icon of the Node                   .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I GET_NODE_NAME                 Delivers Node Name                                          .
IF_BSP_WD_TREE_NODE            I IS_EXPANDED                   Checks Whether Node is Expanded                             .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I CHECK_WD_VIEW_EXISTS          Checks Whether the Provided Web Screen View Exists          .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I CREATE_CONTROLLER             Creates a Controller Instance                               .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I DELETE_CONTROLLER             Deletes a Subcontroller                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_CONTROLLER                Fetches a Subcontroller                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_CONTROLLER_ID_BY_VIEWNAME Delivers Complete ID for a View Name                        .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_HELP_ID                   Delivers ID for Help (ABAP Class Name)                      .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_HISTORY_MANAGER_DISPLAY   Delivers Display Interface of the History Manager           .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_MESSAGE_SERVICE           Returns Message Service                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_OUT                       Fetches the Current Writer                                  .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_REPLACEMENT               Determines Controller/View Replacement                      .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I GET_WORKAREA_VIEW             Delivers View Currently Displayed in Work Area              .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I SET_WORKAREA_OWNER            Set Owner (View Controller) of Work Area                    .
IF_BSP_WD_VIEW_MANAGER         I SET_WORKAREA_REF              Set Work Area Reference                                     .
IF_BSP_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER       I GET_DEFAULT_WINDOW_DEF        Returns Definition of Default/Start Window                  .
IF_BSP_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER       I GET_WINDOW                    Returns Window for Specified Name                           .
IF_BSP_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER       I GET_WINDOW_DEF                Returns Window Definition for Specified Name                .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I CLEAR                         Delete Content                                              .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I ENCODE_STRING                 Endcode String                                              .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I FLUSH_TO_PREVIOUS_WRITER      Writes Content in Previous Writer                           .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I FLUSH_TO_WRITER               Write Content in Specified Writer                           .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I GET_CONTENT                   Writer Content                                              .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I GET_PREVIOUS_WRITER           Previous Writer in Stack                                    .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I NEW_LINE                      Print('\r\n')                                               .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I PRINT                         Write a Text to the Output Stream                           .
IF_BSP_WRITER                  I PRINT_STRING                  Writing Text Section                                        .
IF_BTF                         I CREATE_CONFIGURATION          Create configuration                                        .
IF_BTF                         I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Create Document                                             .
IF_BTF                         I CREATE_EDITOR                 Create Editor                                               .
IF_BTF                         I CREATE_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION   Create Field Administration                                 .
IF_BTF                         I CREATE_LINK_ADMINISTRATION    Create Link Administration                                  .
IF_BTF                         I SET_DESTINATION               Set RFC Destination                                         .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_CREATE_COMMENTS           Reads whether comments are created in the ITF               .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_CREATE_FORMATTING         Reads whether formatting is created                         .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_DEFAULT_FONT              Gets Default Font                                           .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_PARSER_SELECTION          Get Selection of Parser to Be Used                          .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_TABLE_FONTS               Gets Mapping for Fonts as Table                             .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_TABLE_FONTSIZE            Gets Mapping for Font Sizes                                 .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_TABLE_FORMATS             Gets Mapping for Character Formats as Table                 .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_TABLE_PARAGRAPHS          Gets Mapping for Paragraph Formats as Table                 .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I GET_TABLE_STANDARD            Gets Standard Values as Table                               .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_CREATE_COMMENTS           Determines whether comments are created in the ITF          .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_CREATE_FORMATTING         Determines whether formatting is created                    .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_DEFAULT_FONT              Sets Default Font                                           .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_PARSER_SELECTION          Defines Selection of Parser to Be Used                      .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_TABLE_FONTS               Sets Mapping for Fonts as Table                             .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_TABLE_FONTSIZE            Sets Mapping for Font Sizes                                 .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_TABLE_FORMATS             Sets Mapping for Character Formats as Table                 .
IF_BTF_CONFIGURATION           I SET_TABLE_PARAGRAPHS          Sets Mapping for Paragraph Formats as Table                 .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I COLLECT_FIELDS                Find fields                                                 .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I COLLECT_LINKS                 Find Links                                                  .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I CONCATENATE                   Assign attachment                                           .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I CONVERT_CONTENT_TO_ITF        Convert Content to ITF and Get                              .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I GET_CONFIGURATION             Get Configuration                                           .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content                                                 .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I GET_FIELD_SYNTAX              Gets Field Display                                          .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I PARSE_ONLY                    Parse Only (For Test Purposes)                              .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I PRINT                         Internal usage                                              .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I PRINT_WITH_CONFIGURATION      Internal usage                                              .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I REPLACE_FIELDS                Field Replacement                                           .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I REPLACE_LINKS                 Link Replacement                                            .
IF_BTF_DOCUMENT                I SET_CONTENT                   Set Content                                                 .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I FREE                          Release Editor                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I GET_CONTENT                   Read Document Content from Editor                           .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I GET_DESIGN_MODE               Query DesignMode                                            .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I GET_DOCUMENT                  Query Document                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I GET_DRAGDROP                  Query DragDrop                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I GET_IS_MODIFIED               Query IsModified                                            .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I INSERT_FIELD                  Insert Field                                                .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I INSERT_HTML                   Insert Html                                                 .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I INSERT_LINK                   Insert link                                                 .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I SET_CONTENT                   Set Document Content in Editor                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I SET_DESIGN_MODE               Set DesignMode                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I SET_DOCUMENT                  Set Document                                                .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I SET_DRAGDROP                  Set DragDrop                                                .
IF_BTF_EDITOR                  I SET_IS_MODIFIED               Set IsModified                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_EXTERNAL_EDITOR           Query ExternalEditor                                        .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_IMAGE_OPERATIONS          Query ImageOperations                                       .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_LOCAL_OPERATIONS          Query LocalOperations                                       .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_LOCAL_PRINTING            Query LocalPrinting                                         .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_TAB_CONTROL               Query TabControl                                            .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I GET_WINDOWS_FONTS             Query WindowsFonts                                          .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_EXTERNAL_EDITOR           Set ExternalEditor                                          .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_IMAGE_OPERATIONS          Set ImageOperations                                         .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_LOCAL_OPERATIONS          Set LocalOperations                                         .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_LOCAL_PRINTING            Set LocalPrinting                                           .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_TAB_CONTROL               Set TabControl                                              .
IF_BTF_EDITOR_OPTIONS          I SET_WINDOWS_FONTS             Set WindowsFonts                                            .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I GET_ALL_FIELDS                Get Names of all Fields                                     .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I GET_FIELD                     Get Field                                                   .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I GET_LANGUAGE                  Get Language                                                .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I INIT_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION     Initialize Field Administration                             .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I SET_FIELD                     Set Field                                                   .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I SET_FIELDS                    Set Fields                                                  .
IF_BTF_FIELD_ADMINISTRATION    I SET_LANGUAGE                  Set language                                                .
IF_BTF_LINK_ADMINISTRATION     I GET_ALL_LINKS                 Get All Links                                               .
IF_BTF_LINK_ADMINISTRATION     I GET_LINK                      Get Link                                                    .
IF_BTF_LINK_ADMINISTRATION     I INIT_LINK_ADMINISTRATION      Initialize Link Administration                              .
IF_BTF_LINK_ADMINISTRATION     I SET_LINK                      Set Link                                                    .
IF_BTF_LINK_ADMINISTRATION     I SET_LINKS                     Set Links                                                   .
IF_BUKF_TERMS_GRID             I GET_EXCLUDEDFUNCTIONS         Returns the list of excluded functions                      .
IF_BUKF_TERMS_GRID             I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Returns the field catalog corresponding to the term         .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I CAN_CHANGE_PARTNER            Check: May Business Partner Be Changed?                     .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I CAN_DISPLAY_OVERVIEW_IDS      Check: Which Display Formats May Be Displayed?              .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I CAN_DISPLAY_PARTNER           Check: May Business Partner Be Displayed?                   .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I DETERMINE_RELSHIP_ACTIVITY    Check: Which Activity Is Used for the Relationship?         .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I DISPATCH                      Processing of a Function Code                               .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I END                           Initialization: End of a Dialog                             .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I EXTEND_LOCATOR_CONTEXT_MENU   Locator: Extend Context Menu                                .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I EXTEND_LOCATOR_TABSTRIP       Locator: Extend Tabstrip                                    .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I FREE                          Initialization: Release all Resources                       .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I KEEP_LOCATOR_OPEN             Check: Delete Fullscreen Locator for this Function Code?    .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I ON_LOCATOR_CONTEXT_MENU_CLICK Extended Entry Locator Context Menu Was Selected            .
IF_BUPA_DIALOG_JOEL_EXIT       I START                         Initialization: Start of Dialog                             .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I CAN_CHANGE_PARTNER            Check if a Business Parnter May be Changed                  .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I CLEAR_OWNER_MESSAGES          Initializes the Message Table                               .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I COLLECT_MESSAGE               Collect a Message from SY Fields                            .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I CONFIRM_AND_REMOVE_MESSAGES   Confirms and Removes Messages from a Message Table          .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I DISPLAY_CHANGES_POSSIBLE      De/Activates CANCEL, TAKE, SAVE  if No Change Possible      .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I NAVIGATE_TO                   Execute New Navigation Command                              .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I NAVIGATE_TO_DUPLICATE         Navigation to a Duplicate                                   .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I REMOVE_CONFIRMED_MESSAGES_FROMRemoves Already Confirmed Messages from a Message Table     .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I REQUEST_LEAVING               Request to Leave All Active Maintenance                     .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I SET_NAVIGATION_REQUEST        Set Navigation Request                                      .
IF_BUPA_MAINTENANCE_OWNER      I SHOW_PARTNER_POPUP            Display of General Detail Data on Partner                   .
IF_BUPR_OVERVIEW_OWNER         I COLLECT_MESSAGE               Collects Message                                            .
IF_BUSINESS_OBJECT_PPF         I GET_BUSINESS_OBJECT           Read Business Object Reference of the Application           .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I CHANGE_POSTING_DATE           Changes the Posting Date of a Business Transaction          .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I CLONE_TRANSIENT               Generates a Transient Copy of a Business Transaction        .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I DELETE_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION   Deletes a Scheduled Business Transaction                    .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I FIX_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION      Fixes a Scheduled Business Transaction                      .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Provides Elementary Attributes of the Business Transaction  .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_EVENTS                    Provides the Events that have Occurred in the Business Trans.
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_FLOWS                     Gets the Business Transaction Flows                         .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_PARTITIONED_FLOWS         Provides the Flows Split by Partition Category              .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_PARTITIONS                Provides the Flow Partitions of a Category                  .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I GET_USER_DATA                 Provides a Reference to the User Data                       .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I REVERSE_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION  Reverses a Fixed Business Transaction                       .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I SET_EXTBUSTRANSID             Changes the Business Transaction ID Assigned by Generator   .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I SET_FI_POSTING_DATA           Sets Posting Information                                    .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I SET_FLOWS                     Overwrites all the Flows of the Business Transaction        .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I SET_PARTITIONS                Sets the Flow Partitions for a Category                     .
IF_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION_TRD    I SET_PAYMENT_INFO_DATA         Sets Payment Information                                    .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I ACCEPT                        Approval                                                    .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I IS_ACCEPTANCE_ALLOWED         Approval Possible?                                          .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I IS_REJECTION_ALLOWED          Rejection Possible?                                         .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I IS_RESET_ACC_ALLOWED          Can Approval be Cancelled?                                  .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I IS_RESET_REJ_ALLOWED          Can Rejection be Cancelled?                                 .
IF_BUYERS_APPROVAL_MM          I REJECT                        Rejection                                                   .
IF_C2S_ELMNT_TABLE_UTIL        I GET_TABDESCR                  Get description of a customizing table                      .
IF_C2S_ELMNT_TABLE_UTIL        I READ_FOR_GUID                 Get table data from Metadata                                .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Preliminary Data Check as before Saving                     .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I CHECK_FINAL                   Preliminary Data Check as before Activation                 .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I DELETE                        Flag Data for Deletion                                      .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I INSERT                        Create Data                                                 .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I SELECT_FOR_CHANGE             Get Data to Change                                          .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I SELECT_FOR_CHANGE_BY_REL      Get Data to Change from Subnodes                            .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT           I UPDATE                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_MAINT_FACTORY   I GET_INBOUND_IF_MAINT          Request Inbound Adaptor for Changes                         .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_READ            I QUERY_ACT                     Read Active Configuration Data                              .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_READ            I QUERY_ACT_INACT               Read Active and Inactive Configuration Data                 .
IF_C2S_INBOUND_READ            I QUERY_ACT_INACT_CCONT         Read Active and Inactive Configuration in Change Context Def.
IF_C2S_INBOUND_READ_FACTORY    I GET_INBOUND_IF_READ           Request Instance for Read Adaptor                           .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_DATA_TAB_TYPE          Gets instance of C2-internal table type for data            .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_DATA_TYPE              Gets instance of C2-internal data type of a node            .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_KEY_TABLE_TYPE         Gets C2-internal table type for key                         .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_KEY_TYPE               Gets C2-internal key type of a node                         .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_META_TAB_TYPE          Gets table type for C2 meta-data                            .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_META_TYPE              Gets data type for C2 meta-data                             .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_TEXT_TAB_TYPE          Gets C2-internal table type for language-dependent texts    .
IF_C2S_META_C2_TYPES           I GET_C2_TEXT_TYPE              Gets C2-internal type for language-dependent texts          .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_EXIT_NAMES                Known Names                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_EXIT_NAMES_BO             Known Object Exits                                          .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_EXIT_NAMES_FIELD          Known Field Exits                                           .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_EXIT_NAMES_NODE           Known Node Exits                                            .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_INTERFACE_BO              Object Exit Interface                                       .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_INTERFACE_FIELD           Field Exit Interface                                        .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_INTERFACE_NODE            Node Exit Interface                                         .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Description                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I IS_LOCAL                      Executed locally                                            .
IF_C2S_META_EXIT               I IS_VISIBLE                    Visibility for IDE                                          .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I FIELD_IS_CHARLIKE             Character Field?                                            .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_ACTIVE_OBJECT             Active Object                                               .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_ASSOCIATIONS              Associations                                                .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_ASSOCIATION_FIELDS        Associations                                                .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_CHANGE_INFORMATION        Change Information                                          .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_CHILD_NODES               Child nodes                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_EXIT                      Exit                                                        .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_EXITS                     Exit                                                        .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_EXIT_REF                  Exit as Runtime Object                                      .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_FIELD_EXITS               Exit                                                        .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Attribute                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NAME                      Object Name                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_ALL_FIELDS           Node Fields                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_DATA_STRUCTURE       Node Data Structure                                         .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_DATA_STRUCTURE_TYPE  Node Structure Type Descriptor(Only Data Part)              .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_EXT_FIELDS           EEW Include Fields                                          .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_EXT_STRUCTURE        Name of EEW Include                                         .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_FIELDS               Node Data Fields                                            .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_FIELDS_WITH_PROPERTY Fields with Specified Node Property Value                   .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_FIELD_TYPE           Get Field Data Type                                         .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_KEY_FIELDS           Node Key Fields                                             .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_KEY_STRUCTURE_TYPE   Node Key Structure Type Descriptor                          .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_METHOD_NAMES         Method Name                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_METHOD_QUERY         Method Query                                                .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_PARAMETER            Method Parameters                                           .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_STRUCTURE_TYPE       Node Structure Type Descriptor (Key and Data)               .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_NODE_TIP_FIELDS           Time-Dependence Fields                                      .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_PACKAGE                   Get Package Assignment                                      .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_PARENT_ASSOCIATION        Parent Associations                                         .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_PARENT_NODE               Parent Nodes                                                .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_PROPERTIES                Attribute                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_PROPERTY                  Attribute                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Root Node                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT             I IS_CODE                       Is the Node a Code                                          .
IF_C2S_META_OBJECT_APP_SYS     I CREATE                        Create Object                                               .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I CREATE                        Create Persistence Object for Meta-Object                   .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I GET_DEFAULT_SETTINGS          Read Default Persistence Attributes of a Node               .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I GET_SETTINGS                  Read Persistence Attributes of a Node                       .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_C2S_META_PERSISTENCE        I SET_SETTINGS                  Set Persistence Attributes of a Node                        .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_CONFIG_OBJECT             Optional Configuration Object                               .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_DEFAULT                   Default Attribute Value                                     .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES            Known Names                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES_BO         Known Names                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES_FIELD      Known Names                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES_NODE       Known Names                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Description                                                 .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I GET_TYPE                      Data Type                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_PROPERTY           I IS_VISIBLE                    Visible for IDE                                             .
IF_C2S_META_PROP_CHECK         I VALUE_CHECK                   Conifiguration Object Attribute Value Check                 .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I CLEAR                         Delete                                                      .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_COMPILED_QUERY            Compiled Query                                              .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_COMPLETE_QUERY            Execute Query                                               .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_DESCRIPTION               Read Description                                            .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_QUERY                     Get Query                                                   .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_QUERY_PARAMETER           Get Query Parameter                                         .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_QUERY_PARAM_END_DATE      Query Parameter End Date                                    .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_QUERY_PARAM_START_DATE    Query Parameter Start Date                                  .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I GET_QUERY_TYPE                Get Query Type                                              .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I SET_DESCRIPTION               Specify Description                                         .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY              I SET_QUERY                     Specify Query                                               .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I DELETE_PARAMETER              Delete Parameter                                            .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Parameter Description                                   .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I GET_FIELD_NAME                Get Parameter Field Name                                    .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I GET_PARAMETER_NAMES           List of Parameters                                          .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I SET_DESCRIPTION               Specify Parameter Description                               .
IF_C2S_META_QUERY_PARAM        I SET_PARAMETER                 Add/Specify Parameter                                       .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_BCOMODEL      I GET_BO_NAME                   Get BCO Names                                               .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_BCOMODEL      I GET_NODE_NAME                 Get node names                                              .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_BCOMODEL      I SET_BO_NAME                   Set BCO Names                                               .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_BCOMODEL      I SET_NODE_NAME                 Set Node Name                                               .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_FACTORY       I GETGENERATOR                  Returns an Instance of the requested Generator              .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_FACTORY       I GETUTILIZER                   Returns an Instance of the requested user                   .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GENERATOR     I EXECUTE                       Gets the Generator to build the Model                       .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GENERATOR     I GETMODEL                      Returns the Model which the Generator has created           .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GENERATOR     I INIT                          Initializes the Generator with a Context                    .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GEN_CODEPARS  I SET_NODE_NAME                 Intializes the Generator with a business object node        .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GEN_XMIPARS   I SETFILENAME                   Initializes the parser with an XMI filename for uploading   .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_GEN_XMIPARS   I SETXMI                        Initializes the parser with an XMI string                   .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTILIZER      I EXECUTE                       Gets the Utilizer to work with the Model                    .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTILIZER      I INIT                          Initializes the Utilizer with a Context                     .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTILIZER      I SETMODEL                      Set the Model which the Utilizer should use                 .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTIL_APIGEN   I GET_PROTOCOL                  Get Generation Log                                          .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTIL_APIGEN   I SET_BC_SIF                    Set BC Service Interface                                    .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTIL_XMIREND  I GETXMI                        Returns XMI String                                          .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTIL_XMIREND  I SETFILENAME                   Initializes the parser with an XMI filename for downloading .
IF_C2S_SAPIMODEL_UTIL_XMIREND  I SETXMI                        Initializes the parser with an XMI string                   .
IF_C2S_SAPI_DATA_PROVIDER      I READ_DATA                     Read data                                                   .
IF_C2S_SAPI_RUNTIME_FACTORY    I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns an Interface Instance for an Interface Name         .
IF_C2S_SEMANTIC_CHECK          I CHECK_AT_UPDATE               Checks updated and inserted data / only not expensive checks.
IF_C2S_SEMANTIC_CHECK          I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Checks data before save                                     .
IF_C2S_SEMANTIC_CHECK          I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance of Interface                                   .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I ADD_OBJECT_MESSAGE            Add Status Message                                          .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I ADD_OBJECT_MESSAGE_SYMSG      Add Status Message from SY-MSG                              .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE2_SYMSG    Add Process Message (with Object Ref.) from SYMSG           .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE_SYMSG     Add Process Message (w/o Object Ref.) from SYMSG            .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I CLEAR_MESSAGE_HANDLER         Delete All Messages                                         .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I DELETE_OBJECT_MESSAGES        Delete Status Messages                                      .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I GET_ALL_MESSAGES              Read All Messages                                           .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I GET_MESSAGE_TEXT_SYMSG        Get Text from sy-msg                                        .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER          I GET_MESS_FOR_APPL_LOG         Convert Messages for Application Log                        .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I ADD_MESS_FROM_OTHER_INST      Copy Message of a other Message Handler Inst.               .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I ADD_OBJECT_MESSAGE            Add Status Message (Free Text)                              .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE           Add Process Message (w/o Object Ref., Free Text)            .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE2          Add Process Message (with Object Ref., Free Text)           .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I ADD_PROC_MESSAGE_FROM_EXC     Add Process Message (with Object Ref.) From Exception       .
IF_C2_MESSAGE_HANDLER_INT      I DELETE_ALL_MESSAGES           Deletes All Messages of Message Handler                     .
IF_CACHED_PROP                 I GET_NEXT_PROP                 Read Next Property                                          .
IF_CACHED_PROP                 I SEEK_FIRST_PROP               Set Cursor to 1st Property                                  .
IF_CACHED_PROP                 I SET_PROP                      Set a Property                                              .
IF_CALENDAR_APPT_READER        I GET_CUR_DAY                   Determine Current Day                                       .
IF_CALENDAR_APPT_READER        I GET_WEEK_FROM_DAY             Determine Week from Day                                     .
IF_CALENDAR_APPT_READER        I READ_APPOINTMENTS             Read Appointments                                           .
IF_CAPITAL_FLOW_FOR_POS_TRR    I GET_CAPITAL_FLOW              Calculates the Capital Flow of the Position                 .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I CALCULATE_FLOWS               Calculates the Cash Flow                                    .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I CALCULATE_YIELD               Calculates the Yield for Final Due Date                     .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I GET_MASTER_DATA               Returns the Master Data                                     .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I GET_QUANTITY                  Gets Units or Nominals for a Key Date                       .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I GET_YIELD_RELEVANT_FLOWS      Generates the Yield-Relevant Flows                          .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I SET_MASTER_DATA               Sets the Master Data                                        .
IF_CASHFLOW_CALCULATOR_TRS     I SUPPLEMENT_NEW_FLOWS          Cahnges Attribute NEW_FLOWS                                 .
IF_CATS_GROUPSELECT            I GET_GROUPS                    Gets Groups (SelID/ViewID) for Personnel Number             .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I ADD_SELECTION_SCREEN_MOD      Modify Characteristics of a Field in Selection Screen       .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I ADD_TO_FIELD_SELECTION        Transfer Entry to Table of DB Fields to be Selected         .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I DELETE_SELECTION_SCREEN_MOD   Reset Selection Screen Modification                         .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I GET_USER_DEFAULTS             Provide User Settings                                       .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I GET_VARIABLE_VALUE            Provide Value of a Report Variable                          .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I SAVE_USER_DEFAULTS            Save User Settings                                          .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I SET_ALV_VARIANT_INFO          Set ALV List Variant Info.                                  .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I SET_ICON                      Create Icon with Quickinfo                                  .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I SET_USER_DEFAULTS_BUFFER      Write User Settings to Buffer                               .
IF_CATS_REPO                   I SET_VARIABLE_VALUE            Set Value of a Report Variable                              .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I ALV_VARIANT_F4                F4 Help for ALV List Variant                                .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN           PAI for Selection Screen                                    .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN_OUTPUT    PBO for Selection Screen                                    .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I BADI_START_OF_SELECTION       Run start_of_selection Method for BADI                      .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I CHECK_ALV_VARIANT_INFO        Check if Report Name is in Variant Structure                .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I CHECK_ALV_VARIANT_NAME        Check Name of ALV List Variant is Valid                     .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I CHECK_TIME_UNIT               Check Unit of Measure                                       .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I CHECK_VARIANT_NAME            Check Validity of Report Variant                            .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I END_OF_SELECTION              Data selection complete                                     .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I GET_ALV_VARIANT_TEXT          Get Long Text for ALV List Variant                          .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I GET_FIELD_SELECTION           Provide Table of DB Fields to be Selected                   .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I GET_LAST_VARIANT              Provide Variant Last Used by User                           .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I GET_PERAS                     Process GET PERAS Event from LDB PNPCE                      .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I INITIALIZATION                Program Initialization                                      .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I INIT_BADI                     BADI Initialization for Customer Exit Processing            .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I LOAD_OF_PROGRAM               Program Loading Phase                                       .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I SET_INITIAL_TOGGLE_STATE      Set Start Status of Screen Toggles                          .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I SET_QUANTITY_UNIT             Set Unit of Measure for Quantity Field Layout               .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I SET_SELCRIT_ICONS             Icons for selection conditions exist/do not exist           .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I START_OF_SELECTION            Start of Report Run                                         .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I START_WITH_VARIANT            Restart Report with Variant XYZ                             .
IF_CATS_REPORTING              I TOGGLES                       Set Toggle Texts and Show/Hide Fields                       .
IF_CBASE_CHECK                 I CHECK_OWNER                   Check Owner                                                 .
IF_CBASE_CHECK                 I OWNER_TYPE_CHANGE             Authorization for Changing Owner Type                       .
IF_CBASE_TESTING               I CREATE_CFG                    Create Configurations                                       .
IF_CBASE_TESTING               I DELETE_CFG                    Delete Configurations                                       .
IF_CCALC_ACCUM_ICL             I APPLY_LIMDED_PAYI             Add-in Already Applied Limits and Deductibles               .
IF_CCALC_ACCUM_ICL             I BENTYPE_ITEM_TOTAL            Total Up Over Items                                         .
IF_CCALC_ACCUM_ICL             I BENTYPE_WAIVED_TOTAL          Total Up Waived Amounts                                     .
IF_CCALC_ACCUM_ICL             I OTHER_BENTYPE_ITEM_TOTAL_GET  Total Up Over Items                                         .
IF_CCALC_CLAIM_DATA_ICL        I ICL_ITEM_GET                  Get the Claim Items                                         .
IF_CCALC_CLAIM_DATA_ICL        I ICL_PAYI_GET                  Get the Payment Items                                       .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I BENTYPE_PERIOD_GET            Get the allowed benefit types for a period                  .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I CCALC_BENTYPES_GET            Get the Benefit Types Line for an ICL_CCALC Line            .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I CCALC_BENTYPES_MATCH          Get the Benefit Types Line for an ICL_CCALC Line            .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I MESSAGE_ADD                   Add Message to Log                                          .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I PAYMENT_SUBCL_CORRECT         Check and correct payment subclaim                          .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I POLICY_VERSIONS_GET           Get Versions From Policy                                    .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I READ_METHOD_BENTYPES          Benefit Types Matching a Particular Read Method             .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I SUBCLAIM_GET                  Get a subclaim from CCALC MEMORY                            .
IF_CCALC_INT_ICL               I SUBCLAIM_POLPROD_GET          Get Policy Product of a Subclaim                            .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I APPLY_BENTYPE_RULES           APPLY_BENTYPE_RULES                                         .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I APPLY_ITEM_RULES              Calculate Limits for Items                                  .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I APPLY_ITEM_RULES_DEDUCT       Deductible Determination for Grace Days                     .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I CURR_BENTYPE_CALC             CURR_BENTYPE_CALC                                           .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I LIM_DED_APPLY                 lim_ded_apply                                               .
IF_CCALC_NODE_CALC_ICL         I PREP_CURR_BENTYPE_CALC        Called Before the Recursion Downwards                       .
IF_CCALC_RESULT_NODE_ICL       I CCALC_ITEMS_GET               Get CCALC positions corresponding to this node              .
IF_CCALC_RESULT_NODE_ICL       I NODE_CALC                     node_calc                                                   .
IF_CCALC_RESULT_NODE_ICL       I NODE_TYPE_GET                 What Type of Node Is This                                   .
IF_CCALC_RESULT_NODE_ICL       I SUBTREE_CCALC_ITEMS_GET       Get All Items That Fall Under This Benefit Type             .
IF_CCALC_RNODE_BENTYPE_ICL     I ADD_OTHER_DEDUCTS             Add Up Already Deducted From Other Claims                   .
IF_CCALC_RNODE_BENTYPE_ICL     I BENTYPE_ATTRIBS_GET           Get Attributes of Permitted Benefit Types                   .
IF_CCALC_RNODE_BENTYPE_ICL     I OTHER_BENTYPE_TOTAL_GET       Sum of items that contribute to limit, but not to compensatn.
IF_CCALC_RNODE_BENTYPE_ICL     I PREV_PAY_TO_CCALC_ITEMS       prev_pay_to_ccalc_items                                     .
IF_CCALC_RNODE_BENTYPE_ICL     I WRITE_BENTYPE_TOTAL           write_bentype_total                                         .
IF_CCALC_TREE_FRAME_ICL        I PROC_NORMAL_NODE              Process Normal Node                                         .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I COPY_NODE                     Copies a Definition Node Between 2 Parent Nodes             .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I CREATE_REAL_NODE              Creates a Node for an Existing MTE Class                    .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I CREATE_RULE_NODE              Creates a Rule Node in the Definition Tree                  .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I CREATE_VIRTUAL_NODE           Creates a Virtual Node in the Definition Tree               .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I DELETE                        Deletes a Monitor Definition /Complete Definition Tree      .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I DELETE_NODE                   Deletes a Definition Node and All Nodes Below It            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I GET_DEFINITION                Returns the Definition Tree                                 .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I GET_MONITOR                   Return Associated Monitors                                  .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I GET_NODE                      Returns the Content of a Definition Node                    .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization                                       .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I MOVE_NODE                     Move a Definition Node Between 2 Parent Nodes               .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I SAVE                          Saves the Current Monitor Definition to the Database        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I SET_MONITOR                   Set Reference to Associated Monitor                         .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIDEF              I SET_NODE                      Returns the contents of a node                              .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIMESSAGE          I GET_MESSAGE                   Returns the Complete Text of a Message                      .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIMESSAGE          I SET_MESSAGE                   Sets the Message Attributes in Accordance with BAPI Message .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I CHECK                         Object checks its consistency and sets its status           .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I CLONE                         Object creates an identical copy of itself                  .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I DEQUEUE                       Remove Database Lock                                        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I ENQUEUE                       Database lock removed                                       .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I GET_GUID                      Returns the GUID                                            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I GET_NAME                      Returns the Name of the Object (If Available)               .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I GET_NAME2                     Returns the Additional Name (Full Specification)            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I GET_OWNER                     Returns the Creator of the Object (If Known)                .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I GET_STATE                     Object Status: "Database", "Changed", "Contains Errors", ....
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I IS_CONSISTENT                 Check Object Consistency                                    .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIOBJECT           I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I DELETE                        Delete Monitor Set                                          .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the Attributes of the Monitor Set                   .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I GET_SAP_CHANGE_AUTHORIZATION  Returns the Current Modification Authorization              .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I SAVE                          Save monitor set                                            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets the Monitor Set Attributes                             .
IF_CCMS_ALMONISET              I SET_SAP_CHANGE_AUTHORIZATION  Sets the Modification Authorization for SAP Monitor Sets    .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the Description of a Monitor                        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I GET_FOLDER                    Returns the Database Folder of the Monitor                  .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I GET_MONIDEF                   Returns the Reference to the Monitor Definition             .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I GET_MONISET                   Returns the Current Reference to the Monitor Set            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization (Bindings)                            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets the Monitor Description                                .
IF_CCMS_ALMONITOR              I SET_FOLDER                    Sets the Monitor Database Folder                            .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I ACCEPT_CURRENT_VERSION        Confirm Current Version as Last in Container                .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I APPEND_VERSION                Add a New Version                                           .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I DELETE                        Delete Current Version, Cap Version Chain                   .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I FREE                          Release Container                                           .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_GUID                      Returns the Container GUID                                  .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_NAME                      Return Current Name                                         .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_NAME2                     Return Additional Names (such as Monitor Set)               .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_NUMBER_OF_VERSIONS        Returns the Number of Versions in Container                 .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_OWNER                     Return Name of Creator                                      .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I GET_VERSION                   Returns a Reference to the Requested Version                .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of the Version Container                     .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I SAVE                          Save Current Version                                        .
IF_CCMS_ALMONIVERSCONT         I SET_CURRENT_VERSION           Defines the Transferred Object as Current Version           .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_LASTCHG                   Return Last Change                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_RESP_SERVER               Return Responsible Application Server                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_SEGMENT                   Return Segment Reference                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_SEGMNAME                  Return Segment Name                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_SYSID                     Return Name of SAP R/3 Associated with Segment              .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I GET_VERSION                   Return Version                                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_AGENT               I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Data Content                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I DECREASE_WORKING_SET          Reduce Working Set                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I DELETE_WORKING_SET            Delete Worklist                                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I GET_VISUAL_TEST_DATA          Determine Visual Test Data                                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I INCREASE_WORKING_SET          Enlarge Working Set                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I SET_DISPLAY_TIME_ZONE         Set Time Zone for Alert Data Display                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_DATA_VIEWER   I SET_WORKING_SET               Set Worklist for Viewer                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_HANDLER       I READ_ALERT_DATA               Read Asynchronously Determined Alert Data                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_HANDLER       I READ_ALERT_RESET_RC           Read RC of Asynchronous Method "Complete Alerts"            .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_HANDLER       I REQUEST_ALERT_DATA            Trigger Determination of Alert Data                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_ALERT_HANDLER       I REQUEST_ALERT_RESET           Trigger Completion of Alerts                                .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_CTXTCLASS                 Return Context Class                                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_CTXTCLIENT                Return Context Client                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_CTXTOWNER                 Return Context Owner                                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_LASTCHG                   Return Last Change                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_MONSID                    Return Monitored System ID                                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_NAME                      Return Context Name                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_SEGMENT                   Return Segment Associated with Context                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_STATUS                    Return Context Status                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I GET_TYPE                      Return Context Type                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_CONTEXT             I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_DATA_PROXY          I SYNCPOINT_REACHED             Client Has Reached Data Synchronization Point               .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      I DISPATCH_EVENT                Optimize the Event Queue                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      I GET_EVENT_QUEUE               Get the Whole Event Queue                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      I GET_LISTENER_COMPONENT        Get the Listener Reference as Type of VIS_COMPONENT         .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      I GET_NEXT_EVENT_FROM_QUEUE     Get Next Event from Event Queue                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      I RECEIVE_EVENT                 Receive an Event                                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_SENDER        I ADD_EVENT_LISTENER            Add a New Event Listener to List of Listeners               .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_SENDER        I RAISE_EVENT                   Rais an Event                                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_SENDER        I REMOVE_ALL_LISTENERS          Remove All Event Listeners                                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_SENDER        I REMOVE_EVENT_LISTENER         Remove an Event Listener from the List of Listeners         .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_CHILD           I CREATE_TASK_RESPONSE          Create Task Response                                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_CHILD           I SEND_TASK_RESPONSES           Send Task Response to IMC Parent                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_CHILD           I WAIT_FOR_TASK_REQUESTS        Wait for Task Requests                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_COMMUNICATION   I GET_NR_OF_TASK_REQUESTS       Determine Number of Asynchronous Tasks to Be Executed       .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_COMMUNICATION   I RECEIVE_DATA_FIELD            Receive a Data Field from an IMC Partner                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_COMMUNICATION   I RECEIVE_DATA_TABLE            Receive a Data Table from an IMC Partner                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_COMMUNICATION   I SEND_DATA_FIELD               Send a Data Field to IMC Partner                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_COMMUNICATION   I SEND_DATA_TBL                 Send a Data Table to IMC Partner                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_PARENT          I CLOSE_CONNECTION              Close IMC Connection to IMC Child                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_PARENT          I EXECUTE_TASKS                 Execute Registered Tasks in IMC Child                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_PARENT          I GET_TASK_RESPONSES            Read Task Responses from IMC Child                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_IMC_PARENT          I REGISTER_TASK                 Register a Task for Execution in the IMC Child              .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONISET_DIRECTORY   I COMPRESS_DIR_SUBTREE          Compress Directories Subtree                                .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONISET_DIRECTORY   I EXPAND_DIR_SUBTREE            Expand Directories                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONISET_DIRECTORY   I GET_DIRECTORY_PRESENTATION    Read Directory Presentation                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONISET_DIRECTORY   I LOAD_DIRECTORY                Load DB Directory                                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONISET_DIRECTORY   I REFRESH_DIRECTORY             Refresh Directory                                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I CLEANUP                       Release Resources, such as IMC                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I COMPRESS_SUBTREE              Compress Monitor Subtree                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I EDIT_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES       Edit Display Attributes                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I EDIT_MONITOR_DEFINITION       Edit monitor definition                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I EXPAND_SUBTREES               Expand Monitor Subtree                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GENERATE_PRESENTATION         Generate Monitor Presentation                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GENERATE_TEMPLATE             Generate Monitor Template                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GENERATE_ZOOM_PRESENTATION    Generate Presentation for Zoomed Monitor Level              .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GET_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES        Read Display Attributes                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GET_MONITOR_PRESENTATION      Read Monitor Presentation                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GET_REAL_TID_FOR_SUBTREE_NODE Get Read TIDs for a Monitor Subtree                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I GET_TID_FOR_NODE_KEY          Determine TID for Node                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I IS_MTE_AN_ATTRIBUTE           Check Whether an MTE is an Attribute                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I IS_NODE_AN_ATTRIBUTE          Check if Node Key Is an Attribute                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I IS_NODE_ON_TOP                Check if Node Key Is On Top (that is, You Can Zoom Out)     .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I MARK_NODES                    Select Monitor Node                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I SAVE                          Saves the Monitor in the DB                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I SET_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES        Sets Display Attributes                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I SET_GLOBAL_PARAMS             Set Global Parameters for the Monitor                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I SET_SAP_MONIDEF_CHNG_PRIV     Set Authorization for Modification of SAP Monitor Sets      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I ZOOM_IN                       Zoom In One Level in Monitor                                .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR             I ZOOM_OUT                      Zoom Out One Level in Monitor                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I DISPLAY_MONITOR               Display the Monitor (Generate It)                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GENERATE_MONITOR              Generate Monitor Presentation                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GET_ACTUAL_VIEW               Return the Actual View of the Monitor                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GET_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES        Return the Reference to the Monitor Display Attributes      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GET_MONITOR                   Return the Reference to the Monitor Data Instance           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GET_MONITOR_NAME              Return the Name of the Monitor Used                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I GET_MONITOR_SET_ATTRIBUTES    Return the Attributes of the Monitor Set Used               .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I IS_SENDING_EVENTS             Return 'X' if Event Is Raised if an Object Is Selected      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I IS_SUPPORTED_VIEW             Checks if a View Is Supported By the Viewer                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I RAISE_SELECTION_EVENT         Raise the Event to Inform All Components About Selection    .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SEND_SELECTION_EVENT          Define if Event Should Be Raised if an Object Is Selected   .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SET_ACTUAL_VIEW               Set the Actual View of the Monitor                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SET_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES        Set the Reference to the Monitor Display Attributes         .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SET_MONITOR                   Set the Reference to the Monitor Data Instance              .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SET_MONITOR_NAME              Set the Name of the Monitor Used                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I SET_MONITOR_SET_ATTRIBUTES    Set the Attributes of the Monitor Set Used                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_DATA_USER   I UPDATE_MONITOR                Update the Monitor (Update the Monitor Presentation)        .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_FRAMEWORK   I TOGGLE_DISPLAY                Full Screen On / Off for Framework Member                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I CREATE                        Create Monitor Set                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I DELETE                        Delete Monitor Set in DB                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I EDIT_ATTRIBUTES               Edit Monitor Set Attributes                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Read Monitor Set Attributes                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I GET_MONITOR_DIRECTORY         Determine the Directory of Monitors for Monitor Set         .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I LOAD                          Load Monitor Set from DB                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I SAVE                          Save Monitor Set in DB                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I SHOW_ATTRIBUTES               Display Monitor Set Attributes                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_SET         I TRANSPORT_MONISET             Transport monitor set                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_MONITOR_VIEWER      I DISPLAY_MONITOR               Display Monitor in Monitor Viewer                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_MTE_DATA_RETRIEVER  I CREATE_PERF_MTE_SAMPLE_CTXT   Create Sample Context for a Particular Time Interval        .
IF_CCMS_AL_MTE_DATA_RETRIEVER  I READ_MTE_DATA                 Read MTE Data                                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_MTE_DATA_RETRIEVER  I REQUEST_MTE_DATA              Request MTE Data                                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_MTE_DATA_RETRIEVER  I SET_TIMEZONE                  Set Time Zone for Representation of MTE Data                .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_KEY          I COMPARE_TO                    Compares Two Object Keys                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_KEY          I GET_DATA                      Get the Key Content (Object-Specific)                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_KEY          I SET_DATA                      Set the Key Content (Object-Specific)                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I ADD_TO_OBJECT_SET             Add One or More Objects to the Actual Object Set            .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I CHECK_OBJECT_DATA_STATUS      Return 'X' if the Object Data Should Be Updated             .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I CLEAR_OBJECT_SET              Clear the Actual Object Set                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I CLONE                         Clone the Actual Object Set                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_CAPTIONS_OF_OBJECTS       Return a Table of Captions of All Objects                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_CAPTION_OF_OBJECT         Return the Caption of the Specified Object                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_DOCUMENTATION_TO_OBJECT   Return the Documentation to the Specified Object            .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_FILTER                    Return the Actual Object Set Filter                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_INDEX_OF_OBJECT           Return the Index of the Specified Object                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_NAME_OF_OBJECT_SET        Return the Name of the Object Set                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_NUMBER_OF_OBJECTS         Return the Number of Objects in the Object Set              .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_OBJECT                    Return the Specified Object                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_OBJECT_BY_INDEX           Return the Object at the Specified Index                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_OBJECT_PROPERTIES         Return a Table Describing the Object Details                .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_OBJECT_PROPERTY_GROUPS    Return a Table Describing the Groups of Object Details      .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I GET_OBJECT_SET                Return the Set of Objects                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I IS_EMPTY                      Check if the Selection Is Empty                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I IS_PART_OF_OBJECT_SET         Return 'X' if the Object Is Part of the Object Set          .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I LOAD_OBJECT_DATA              Load Required Object Data                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I MERGE_WITH_OBJECT_SET         Merge the Actual Object Set with the Specified Object Set   .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I REMOVE_FROM_OBJECT_SET        Remove One or More Objects from the Actual Object Set       .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I SET_FILTER                    Set the Actual Object Set Filter                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I SET_OBJECT_SET                Set the Actual Object Set                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET          I SET_OBJECT_SET_NAME           Set the Name of the Object Set                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET_FILTER   I CHECK_OBJECT                  Check Whether a Certain Object Should Be Filtered or Not    .
IF_CCMS_AL_OBJECT_SET_FILTER   I OPTIMIZE_OBJECT_SET           Optimize the Whole Object Set                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_PARAMETER_VALUE     I GET_DEFAULT                   Return the Default Value                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_PARAMETER_VALUE     I GET_LAST_VALUE                Return the (User-Specific) Value                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_PARAMETER_VALUE     I SET_DEFAULT                   Set the Default Value                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_PARAMETER_VALUE     I SET_LAST_VALUE                Set the (User-Specific) Value                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_PERSONALISATION     I DEFINE_DEFAULT_PARAMETER_SET  Define the Default Parameter Set (Component-Specific)       .
IF_CCMS_AL_PERSONALISATION     I DEFINE_PARAMETER_SET          Define the Actual Parameter Set (Component-Specific)        .
IF_CCMS_AL_PERSONALISATION     I LOAD_PARAMETER_SET            Read the Actual Parameter Set                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_PERSONALISATION     I SAVE_PARAMETER_SET            Save the Actual Parameter Set                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_PERSONALISATION     I UPDATE_PARAMETER_SET          Update the Actual Parameter Set (Component-Specific)        .
IF_CCMS_AL_RFC_CONNECTIONS     I GET_RFC_CONNECTIONS           Return RFC Connections                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_AGENTS                    Return Agents Table                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_CONTEXTS                  Return Context References Table                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_DESTATT                   Return Destination-Dependent Attribute                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_NAME                      Return Segment Name                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_RESP_SERVER               Return Responsible Application Server                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_SEGMHOST                  Return Associated Host                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_SEGMSERVER                Return Associated Server                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_SYSID                     Return Name of SAP R/3 Associated with Segment              .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_SYSTEM                    Return System Reference                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_TYPE                      Return Segment Type                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I GET_VERSION                   Return Monitoring Infrastructure Version                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEGMENT             I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Data Content                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I ADD_TO_SELECTION              Add One or More Items to the Current Selection              .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I CLEAR_SELECTION               Clear the Current Selection                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I GET_NUMBER_OF_SELECTED_ITEMS  Return the Number of Selected Items                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I GET_SELECTION                 Return the Set of Selected Items                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I GET_SELECTION_MODE            Return the Current Selection Mode(SINGLE or MULTI Selection).
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I IS_EMPTY                      Check if the Selection Is Empty                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I IS_SELECTED                   Check if an Item Is Part of the Actual Selection            .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I REMOVE_FROM_SELECTION         Remove One or More Items from the Current Selection         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I SET_ALL_SELECTED              Set All Objects to Selected                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I SET_SELECTION                 Set the Current Selection                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_SELECTION_MODEL     I SET_SELECTION_MODE            Set the Selection Mode (SINGLE or MULTI Selection)          .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEL_MODEL_USER      I GET_SELECTION_MODEL           Set the Reference to a Selection Model                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_SEL_MODEL_USER      I SET_SELECTION_MODEL           Return the Reference to a Selection Model                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I GET_CSMSTATUS                 Return Internal Communication Status                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I GET_DESTINAT_ANA              Return Analysis Destination                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I GET_LASTCHG                   Return Last Change                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I GET_SYSID                     Return SAP R/3 Name                                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I GET_VERSION                   Return Monitoring Version                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_SYSTEM              I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I DEFINE_TOOLBAR                Define the Toolbar                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I GET_DROPDOWN_CONTENT          Return the Dropdown Content for a Certain FCODE             .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I GET_TOOLBAR                   Return the Actual Toolbar Reference                         .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Return the Set of Buttons Used in the Toolbar               .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I SET_TOOLBAR                   Set the Toolbar Reference                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I SET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Set the Set of Buttons Used in the Toolbar                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_TOOLBAR_USER        I UPDATE_TOOLBAR_STATUS         Update the Status of the Toolbar (Buttons)                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_UIA_DATACOLLECTOR   I GET_FCAT                      Deliver Field Catlog                                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_UIA_DATACOLLECTOR   I GET_TABLE                     Deliver Table Content                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I ACTIVATE                      Activate Visual Component in a GUI Container                .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I DESTROY                       Destroy Visual Component                                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_AS_EVENT_LISTENER         Return a Reference with Type IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_LISTENER      .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_AS_EVENT_SENDER           Return a Reference with Type IF_CCMS_AL_EVENT_SENDER        .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_AS_WEB_COMPONENT          Return a Reference with Type IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_CAPTION                   Determine Component Caption                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_COMPONENT_CONTAINER       Get Reference to Component Container                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_COMPONENT_GUID            Return the Component GUID                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_COMPONENT_MENU            Return the Content of the Component Menu                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns Reference to the Application Components Container   .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_HEADER                    Returns Reference to Header Area                            .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_HEADER_INFO               Determine Info in Header Area                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_MAXIMUM_SIZE              Return the Maximum Size of the Component                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_MINIMUM_SIZE              Return the Minimum Size of the Component                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_NAME                      Determine Name of a Component                               .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I GET_PREFERRED_SIZE            Return the Preferred Size of the Component                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I HANDLE_MENUE_ENTRY_SELECTED   Event Handler to Handle the Selection of a Menu Entry       .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_ACCESSIBLE                 Return TRUE if the Component Is Accessible                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_COMPONENT_BUSY             Is Component Busy?                                          .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_COMPRESSED                 Delivers TRUE if Component is Iconized                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_HEADER_ENABLED             Is Header Area in Component Activated/Deactivated?          .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_RUNNING_STANDALONE         Return TRUE if Component Runs Standalone                    .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_TOOLBAR_ENABLED            Is Toolbar in Component Activated/Deactivated?              .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I IS_VISIBLE                    Returns TRUE if Component Is Visible                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I RESET                         Reset Visual Component                                      .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_CAPTION                   Set Caption for Component                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_COMPONENT_CONTAINER       Set the Reference to the Component Container                .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_CONTAINER                 Container for Application Components                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_HEADER                    Set Header Area                                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_HEADER_ENABLED            Activate/Deactivate Header Area for Component               .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_HEADER_INFO               Set Info in Header Area                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_NAME                      Set Name of a Component                                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_TOOLBAR                   Set Toolbar                                                 .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_TOOLBAR_ENABLED           Activate/Deactivate Toolbar for Components                  .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_COMPONENT       I SET_VISIBILITY                Inform a Component if it Is Visible/Invisible               .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I ADD_DISPATCHER_TO_PATH        Define the Last Dispatcher of the Event                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I GET_DATA                      Gets Event Data                                             .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I GET_NAME                      Return the Name of the Event                                .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I GET_SENDER                    Gets the Event Sender                                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I IS_DISPATCHER_PART_OF_PATH    Return the Last Dispatcher of the Event                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_EVENT           I OPTIMIZE_EVENT_QUEUE          Optimizes the Event Queue                                   .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I ADD_CHILD_CONTROLLER          Adds a Child Component to the Hierarchy                     .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I DISPATCH_EVENT                Propagates an Event in the Hierarchy                        .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I GET_EVENT_Q                   Reads the Complete Event Queue                              .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I GET_NEXT_EVENT_FROM_Q         Read the Next Event to Be Processed from the Queue          .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I REMOVE_CHILD_CONTROLLER       Deletes a Child Component from the Hierarchy                .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I RESET_PARENT_CONTROLLER       Deletes the Reference to the Parent Controller              .
IF_CCMS_AL_VIS_HIERARCHY_CNTL  I SET_PARENT_CONTROLLER         Sets the Parent Controller of a Hierarchy Controller        .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I GET_DRAG_DROP_BEHAVIOUR       Return the DRAG and DROP Behavior                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I GET_FORM_NAME                 Return the Name of the HTML Form Used                       .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I GET_HTML_PAGE                 Return the HTML Code That Renders the Component             .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I GET_PAGE_NAME                 Return Name of the Page That Reners the Component Content   .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I HAS_SCROLLABLE_CONTENT        Return 'X' if the Content Should Be Scrollable              .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I ON_INPUT_PROCESSING           'OnInputProcessing' Event Handler for the Component         .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I ON_MANIPULATION               'OnManipulation' Event Handler for the Component            .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I SET_CONTENT_TO_SCROLLABLE     Define if Content Should Be Scrollable or Not               .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I SET_DRAG_DROP_BEHAVIOUR       Define the DRAG and DROP Behavior                           .
IF_CCMS_AL_WEB_COMPONENT       I SET_FORM_NAME                 Set the Name of the HTML Form Used                          .
IF_CCM_CMPWSP_CIC_EV_HANDLER   I HANDLE_EVENT                  Event Handler                                               .
IF_CCM_NAV_NODE_FATHER         I ADD_CHILD_NODE                Add a child node                                            .
IF_CCM_NAV_NODE_PRESENTATOR    I BUILD_NODE_PRESENTATION       build the presentation for a navigation node                .
IF_CCM_NAV_NODE_PRES_BUILDER   I BUILD_NODE_PRESENTATION       Builds the presentation for a navigation node               .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_ABOX           I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA_SOURCE    Adds Additonal Data Source Elements to Action Box Data Flow .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_ABOX           I GET_CALL_GROUPS               Returns Call Groups for Action Box Definition               .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_ABOX           I SET_PROFILE                   Sets the profile                                            .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_DESCRIPTOR     I GET_CLUSTER_BUILDER           returns the cluster builder                                 .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_DESCRIPTOR     I GET_INSTANCE                  returns an instance of the class                            .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_DESCRIPTOR     I GET_TREE_BUILDER              returns the tree builder                                    .
IF_CCM_NAV_VIEW_TOOLBAR        I GET_TOOLBAR_HANDLER           Delivers Toolbar Handler                                    .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Check Whether Class Implements a Specific Class Name        .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_CLASS                     Return Class (Agent)                                        .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_CLASS_DESCRIPTION         Creates an Instance for Current Class                       .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_CLASS_ID                  Provides Attribute List for Current Class                   .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_PERSISTENT                Get Class Name for This Class                               .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I GET_RELATIONS                 Supply Dependency List for This Class                       .
IF_CCM_OP_CLASS                I IS_CLASS_ID                   Return Class Description                                    .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I ADD_OBJECT                    Add an object to the cluster                                .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I ADD_RELATION                  Add a relation to the cluster                               .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I ADD_RELATION_ELEMENT          Add a relation instance to a cluster                        .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I ADD_ROOT_OBJECT               Add a root element                                          .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I GET_ROOT_OBJECTS              get table of root elements                                  .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER              I SET_CLUSTER_BUILDER           Set the cluster builder object                              .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER      I BUILD_ON_ELEMENT_ACCESS       extend cluster on element access                            .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER      I BUILD_ON_RELATION_ACCESS      extend cluster on relation access                           .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER      I BUILD_ON_ROOT_ADDED           build cluster when a root element has been added            .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER      I SET_CLUSTER                   set cluster                                                 .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_ELEMENT      I ADD_RELATION                  add a relation to an object                                 .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_ELEMENT      I GET_REF_OBJECT                get reference object of cluster element                     .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_ELEMENT      I GET_RELATIONS                 get relations of element                                    .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_ELEMENT      I SET_BUILT                     set element to built status                                 .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_ELEMENT      I SET_UNBUILT                   set element to unbuilt status                               .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_REL          I GET_DESTINATION_COUNT         get number of relation elements                             .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_REL          I GET_RELATION_TYPE             get relation type                                           .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_REL          I GET_SOURCE_ELEMENT            get source element of the relation                          .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_REL          I SET_BUILT                     set relation to built status                                .
IF_CCM_OP_CLUSTER_REL          I SET_UNBUILT                   set relation to unbuilt status                              .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Supplies the Value of an Attribute                          .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT               I GET_CLASS                     Supply Class Object for Object                              .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT               I GET_OBJECT_KEY                Supply Key for This Object                                  .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT               I GET_RELATED_OBJECTS           Provides Objects Related to this Object                     .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT_MODIFY        I SET_OBJECT_DATA               Set the Structure of the Object Data Externally             .
IF_CCM_OP_OBJECT_MODIFY        I SET_VIRTUAL_ATTRIBUTE_DATA    Set the Value of the Virtual Attribute Externally           .
IF_CCM_SUBSCREEN_WORKSPACE     I PAI_AFTER                     called after Call Subscreen in PAI                          .
IF_CCM_SUBSCREEN_WORKSPACE     I PAI_BEFORE                    called before Call Subscreen in PAI                         .
IF_CCM_SUBSCREEN_WORKSPACE     I PBO_AFTER                     called after Call Subscreen in PBO                          .
IF_CCM_SUBSCREEN_WORKSPACE     I PBO_BEFORE                    called before Call Subscreen in PBO - returns screen number .
IF_CCM_TREE_BUILDER            I BUILD_COLUMNS                 Build the columns of a navigation tree                      .
IF_CCM_TREE_BUILDER            I BUILD_TREE                    Build the nodes of a navigation tree                        .
IF_CCM_TREE_BUILDER            I SET_TREE                      Set the tree object                                         .
IF_CCM_TREE_BUILDER            I SET_TREE_PROPERTIES           Set the general tree properties                             .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I CREATE                        creates a new workspace                                     .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I DELETE                        Deletes a workspace                                         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I EXECUTE                       Execution of a workspace                                    .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_ACTIONS                   returns all valid actions including their callback methods  .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_CCPROC_CLASS_ID           returns CCPROC class id                                     .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_CONCURRENCY               flag: workspace supports concurrency                        .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_CONTAINER                 returns workspace container                                 .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_DISPLAY_TEXT              returns workspace display text                              .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_INTERFACE                 returns interface of a workspace                            .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_LIFTIME                   returns lifetime flag                                       .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I GET_WS_DISPLAY                gets the display object for a workspace                     .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I REMOVE_WS_DISPLAY             removes the display object for a workspace                  .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I SET_DISPLAY_TEXT              sets workspace display text                                 .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I SET_LIFTIME                   sets lifetime flag                                          .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I SET_VISIBLE                   sets visibility of a workspace                              .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I SET_WS_DISPLAY                sets the display object for a workspace                     .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE               I UPDATE_DISPLAY_DATA           allows to adjust control data on pbo event                  .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_BROWSER_BACK               browser backward                                            .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_BROWSER_FRWD               browser forward                                             .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_BROWSER_HOME               navigate to home page                                       .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_BROWSER_REFRESH            refresh current browser page                                .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_BROWSER_STOP               stop browser navigation                                     .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_DELETE_WS                  delete workspace                                            .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_HELP                       help page requested                                         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_RESUME                     resume interrupted workspace                                .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_CALLBACK      I CB_STATUS                     status/trace                                                .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_DISPLAY       I DELETE                        deletes a workspace display                                 .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_DISPLAY       I GET_GUI_CONTAINER             returns the gui container for a workspace's control         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_DISPLAY       I IS_VISIBLE                    returns if workspace is currently visible                   .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_DISPLAY       I LINK_NEW_WORKSPACE            links a new workspace to the display                        .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_EXTENSION     I GET_DISPLAY_ICON              Sets Workspace Display Icon                                 .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_FACTORY       I INSTANTIATE_WORKSPACE         returns an obejct implementing the workspace interface      .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I CREATE_WORKSPACE              creates a workspace                                         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I DELETE_ALL_WORKSPACES         deletes all workspaces                                      .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I DELETE_WORKSPACE              deletes a workspace                                         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I EXECUTE_WORKSPACE             executes a workspace                                        .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I HAS_DISPLAY_CLIENT            true if a display client is registered                      .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I REGISTER_DISPLAY_CLIENT       registers a display client                                  .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I RESUME_WORKSPACE              resumes a workspace                                         .
IF_CCM_WORKSPACE_MANAGER       I SET_REPLACE_WORKSPACE         sets the workspace to be replaced next                      .
IF_CCM_WSM_DISPLAY             I CREATE_WS_DISPLAY             creates a new workspace display                             .
IF_CCM_WSM_DISPLAY             I SELECT_WS_DISPLAY             selects a workspace display                                 .
IF_CD_COSTING_COMPONENT        I GET_PRICING_DATE              Read Valuation Data                                         .
IF_CD_COSTING_COMPONENT        I GET_STRATEGIES                Read Valuation Strategy Sequence                            .
IF_CD_COSTING_COMPONENT        I SET_PRICING_DATE              Set Valuation Date                                          .
IF_CD_COSTING_COMPONENT        I SET_STRATEGIES                Set Valuation Strategy                                      .
IF_CFX_BADI_BI_EXPORT          I AFTER_EXPORT_COMPLETE         After Exporting All Objects                                 .
IF_CFX_BADI_BI_EXPORT          I CHECK_EXPORT_CHANGE_PRE       Check + Change Objects in Selection of Existing Collaboratns.
IF_CFX_BADI_BI_EXPORT          I CHECK_EXPORT_CREATE_PRE       Check + Change Objects When Creating a New Collaboration    .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I CHECK                         Checks Consistency of Assignments                           .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I COPY                          Creates a Copy of the Object Assignment                     .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I DELETE                        Delete Object Assignment                                    .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I EXECUTE_STATUS_ACTIVITY       Execute Business Activity of Status Management              .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I GET_ASSIGNMENTS               Returns Assignment Collection Object                        .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I GET_FREE_PERMISSION           Checks if Node Assignment Can Be Destroyed                  .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Determines Object Type                                      .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I GET_PARENT                    Returnes Parent Object                                      .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I GET_PERSISTENCY_CONTROLLER    Returns Persistence Object for Assignment Type              .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I SET_ASSIGNMENTS               Sets Assignment Collection Object                           .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT             I SET_PARENT                    Sets Parent Object                                          .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_ARCHIVING   I DELETE                        Deletion of Archived Assignments                            .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_ARCHIVING   I PRE_FETCH                     Flag Assignment Objects for Reading from Archive            .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_ARCHIVING   I WRITE                         Write Assignments to Archive                                .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I CHECK_CHANGES                 Determines Whether Changes Exist                            .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I FETCH                         Assignment Object Selection from DB                         .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I INITIALIZE                    Initializierung According to COMMIT WORK                    .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I PRE_FETCH                     Mark Assignment Objects for Data Base Selection             .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I REFRESH                       Destructor - Initialization of All Data                     .
IF_CGPL_ASSIGNMENT_PERSISTENCY I SAVE                          Save changes                                                .
IF_CGPL_AUTHORITY_CHECK        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Call Authorization Check                                    .
IF_CGPL_STATUS_MANAGEMENT      I ACTIVITY_CHECK                Business Activity Check                                     .
IF_CGPL_STATUS_MANAGEMENT      I GET_PERMITTED_CHANGES         Determines Permitted Status Changes (System/User Status)    .
IF_CGPL_USER_OPTIONS           I GET_SUBSCREEN_FOR_USER_OPTIONSDelivers Screen and Programs for User Settings              .
IF_CGPL_USER_OPTIONS           I GET_USER_OPTIONS              Read User Settings from Subscreen                           .
IF_CGPL_USER_OPTIONS           I SET_USER_OPTIONS              Set User Settings on Subscreen                              .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I CAST_OBJECT_CHANGED           Informs Display Object of Object Change                     .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I CAST_OBJECT_DELETED           Informs Display Object of Object Deletion                   .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I CHECK_OBJECT                  Checks Application Object                                   .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Transfer Interface Function Code for Execution              .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_ASSIGN_MENU               Request Menu with Assignment Functions                      .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Request for Context Menu Functions                          .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_CREATE_MENU               Request for Menu with Create Functions                      .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Request for Display Characteristics                         .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_OBJECT                    Request for Reference to Object to Be Displayed             .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Request for Type of Object to Be Displayed                  .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I PREPARE_OUTPUT                Preparation for Displaying Using Subscreen Call             .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I SET_OBJECT                    Sets Object to Be Displayed                                 .
IF_CGPL_VISUALIZE              I VISUALIZE                     Display in a Control Container                              .
IF_CHDOC_CONTAINER_MM          I CHECK_UNDO                    Check re Undos                                              .
IF_CHDOC_CONTAINER_MM          I GET_ALLOWED_FIELDS            Field List                                                  .
IF_CHDOC_CONTAINER_MM          I GET_DATA                      Get Change Documents                                        .
IF_CHDOC_CONTAINER_MM          I ROLLBACK                      Rollback Changes                                            .
IF_CHDOC_CONTAINER_MM          I UPDATE                        Updating of Change Documents                                .
IF_CHECK_UOM                   I CHECK_TY2TQ                   Check Changes in Category of Alternative Unit of Measure    .
IF_CHK_IMG                     I CHECK                         Checks the Object                                           .
IF_CIF_ENHANCED                I CHANGE_SHPPNT_OUT             Change Transfer Data for Shipping Points                    .
IF_CIF_ENHANCE_ERRHDL          I ENHANCE_ERROR_HANDLING        Enhance CIF Error Handling                                  .
IF_CI_COLLECTOR                I COLLECT                       Triggers Object Collector                                   .
IF_CI_COLLECTOR                I DISPLAY_DOCUMENTATION         Display Documentation                                       .
IF_CI_COLLECTOR                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Supply Collector Properties                                 .
IF_CI_COLLECTOR                I PUT_ATTRIBUTES                Set Collector Properties                                    .
IF_CI_COLLECTOR                I QUERY_ATTRIBUTES              Query Attributes                                            .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I EVALUATE                      Evaluates Explain Plan                                      .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I EXPLAIN                       Executes Explain                                            .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I EXPLAIN_AND_EVALUATE          Executes and Evaluates Individual Explain                   .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I READ_CC_STATEMENTS            Gets SQL statments form cursor cache                        .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I READ_CC_STATISTICS            Gets cursor cache statistics                                .
IF_CI_CURSOR_CACHE             I SQL_TRACE_ANALYZE             Executes and Evaluates SQL Trace Explains                   .
IF_CI_TEST                     I DISPLAY_DOCUMENTATION         Display documentation                                       .
IF_CI_TEST                     I EXCEPTION                     Declare Exception                                           .
IF_CI_TEST                     I NAVIGATE                      Navigate                                                    .
IF_CI_TEST                     I QUERY_ATTRIBUTES              Query Attributes                                            .
IF_CK_MM_NODE_GUI              I GET_ICON                      Icon for Node                                               .
IF_CK_MM_NODE_GUI              I GET_TEXT_DESCRIPTION          Text of Description                                         .
IF_CK_MM_NODE_GUI              I GET_TEXT_KEY                  Text of Key                                                 .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CHECK_OBJECT_STATUS           Check Object Status Before Loading Graph for Data Cleansing .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_CHANGE               Change Data Cleansing Object                                .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_DELETE               Delete Data Cleansing Object(Deleteion Flag, Archiving Flag).
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_GET_DETAILS          Read Details of One of More Objects                         .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_RELEASE              Release Data Cleansing Object (Reset Status/Lock)           .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_ROLLBACK             Roll Back Changes to Main Object                            .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I CLEARING_SAVE                 Make Change Persistent                                      .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I ENHANCE_DESCRIPTION           Determing Language-Dependent Object Description             .
IF_CLEARING_OBJECT             I FILL_ROOT_APPL_KEY            Generate Application Key of Header Object                   .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_CHANGE              Change Data Cleansing Object                                .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_CHECK_COPY          Check if Copying is Possible (Initial Creation at Target)   .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_CHECK_CUT           Check if Reassignment is Possible (Incl. Deletion of Orig.) .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_CHECK_DETAIL        Check if Detailed Comparison is Permitted                   .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_DELETE              Delete Referencing Object                                   .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_ENHANCE_DESC        Determing Language-Dependent Object Description             .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_GET_DETAILS         Read Details of One of More Objects                         .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_GET_REFERENCES      Determine All Referencing Objects                           .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_INSERT              Insert Reference for Target Object                          .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_ROLLBACK            Rollback Changes                                            .
IF_CLEARING_REFERRING_OBJECT   I CLEAR_REF_SAVE                Make Change Persistent                                      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_ACCEPT                    Corresponds to the HTTP request header ACCEPT               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_ALERTING_SUPPORTED        Specifies whether notifcation such as SMS is supported      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_ANCHOR_PREV_SUPPORTED     Specifies whether back action using "anchor" tag is possible.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_ANCHOR_SUPPORTED          Specifies whether the "anchor" tag is supported             .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_APP_LINKS_SUPPORTED       Specifies if the e. loc. application can be called by link  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_APP_LINK_TYPES            Specifies which type of application links are possible      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BACK_HARD_WIRED           Specifies if back action can be executed without "do" tag   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BACK_LABEL                Specifies whether back labels are represented by label atts .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BACK_TO_ANY_URL_SUPPORTED Specifies whether back action is possible for any URL       .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BIG_SUPPORTED             Specifies whether text can be formatted as large            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BOLD_SUPPORTED            Specifies whether text can be formatted as bold             .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BREAKING_SPACE            Returns the smallest string for a blank character           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BROWSER_CATEGORY          Returns the Browser category                                .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BROWSER_NAME              Returns the name of the Browser                             .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BROWSER_OS                Returns the operating system to the end device              .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_BROWSER_VERSION           Returns the Browser version, such as 5.5                    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CACHE_ENABLED_BY_DEFAULT  Specifies whether Browser caching is activated by default   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CERTIFICATES_SUPPORTED    Specifies whether the device supports client certificates   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CHAR_HEIGHT               Returns the screen height in rows                           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CHAR_WIDTH                Returns the screen width in characters                      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_COLOR_DEPTH               Returns the color intensity, such as 256 colors             .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_COLOR_SUPPORTED           Specifies whether the device has a color screen             .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Returns the content type, such as HTML or WML               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CONTENT_TYPE_VERSION      Returns the version of the content type                     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_COOKIES_SUPPORTED         Specifies whether the Browser supports cookies              .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CSS_SUPPORTED             Specifies whether the Browser supports cascading style sheet.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_CSS_VERSION               Returns the CSS version                                     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEFAULT_ACTION_DESIGN     Returns the preferred interface element for actions         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEFAULT_BLOCK_SEPARATOR   Returns the preferred character string to separate paragrphs.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEFAULT_BULLET            Returns the preferred symbol to label list points           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEFAULT_FORM_STYLE        Returns the preferred display type for input templates      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEFAULT_MENU_STYLE        Returns the preferred display type for menus                .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEVICE_CATEGORY           Returns the category of the end device                      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DEVICE_NAME               Returns the name of the end device                          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DOM_SUPPORTED             Specifes whether the device supports DOM                    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_DOM_VERSION               Returns the DOM version that is supported                   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_EMPHASIZED_SUPPORTED      Specifies whether text can be formatted as highlighted      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_EMULATOR                  Specifies whether the end device can be catgrzd as emulator .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FIELDSET_LAYOUT           Rerurns the type of input field grouping                    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FIELDSET_TITLE_VISIBLE    Specifies whether the title is displayed with field sets    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FONT_PROPORTIONAL         Specifies whether proportional font is specified            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FORM_FACTOR               Returns the form factor of the end device                   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FORM_MENU_SUPPORTED       Specifies whether forms are possible with the preset menu   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_FRAMES_SUPPORTED          Specifies whether the Browser supports frames               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_GRAY_LEVEL                Returns the number of gray tones with gray-scale pictures   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_HORZ_SCROLLING_SUPPORTED  Specifies whether the device has a horizontal scrollbar     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_HREF_WITH_PARAMS_SUPPORTEDSpecifies whether the HREF attribute can contain URL params .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_HTTP_GET_SUPPORTED        Specifies whether HTTP GET is supported                     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_HTTP_POST_SUPPORTED       Specifies whether HTTP POST is supported                    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_IMAGE_ALIGNMENT_SUPPORTED Specifies whether graphics can be aligned                   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_IMAGE_LINKS_SUPPORTED     Specifies whether a graphic can be used as a link           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_IMAGE_SIZE_MAX            Returns the max. memory size of a graphic                   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_FORMAT_DATE         Returns the string that checks the date values              .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_FORMAT_NUMERIC      Returns the string that checks the numerical values         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_METHOD_HAND_WRITING Specifies whether handwriting recognition is supported      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_METHOD_KEYBOARD     Specifies whether data can be input using the keyboard      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_METHOD_KEYPAD       Specifies whether data can be input using telephone keypad  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_METHOD_KEYPAD_INTELLSpecifies whether T9 text input is supported                .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_METHOD_VOICE        Specifies whether language input is supported for data      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_INPUT_SHOWN_WITH_CAPTION  Specifies whether the title attribute is used as a label    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_ITALIC_SUPPORTED          Specifies whether text can be formatted in italics          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_JAVA_SUPPORTED            Specifies whether the programming language supports Java    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_JAVA_VERSION              Returns the Java version that is supported                  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_LINKS_SEPARATED           Specifies whether two consecutive links are separated       .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_LINK_DECORATION           Specifies the surrounding character of a link text          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_LINK_TEXT_WIDTH           Returns the number of characters in a row                   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_LOCAL_IMAGES_SUPPORTED    Specifies if the device supports local graphics or symbols  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_LOCAL_VARIABLES_SUPPORTED Specifies whether the Browser supports local variables      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MARQUEE_LINK_SUPPORTED    Specifies whether excessively long links can be wrapped     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MARQUEE_TEXT_SUPPORTED    Specifies whether excessively long texts can be wrapped     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MAX_LINK_LENGTH           Returns the max. size of the HREF attribute of a link       .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MEDIA_FORMATS             Returns the list of the multimedia formats that are supprted.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MEMORY                    Returns the max. main memory capacity of the device         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_MODEL                     Returns the name of the device type                         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NBSP_SUPPORTED            Specifies whether non-breaking characters are supported     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NESTED_TABLES_SUPPORTED   Specifies whether nested tables are supported               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_AFTER_IMAGE       Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after an "img" tag     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_AFTER_INPUT       Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after an "input" tag   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_AFTER_LINK        Specifies whether a "br/" is inserted after a link          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_AFTER_SELECT      Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after a "select" tag   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BEFORE_IMAGE      Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after an "img" tag     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BEFORE_INPUT      Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after an "img" tag     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BEFORE_LINK       Specifies whether a "br/" is interted before a link         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BEFORE_SELECT     Specifies whether a "br" is inserted after a "select" tag   .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BETWEEN_IMAGES    Specifies whether a "br" is inserted betweem "img" tags     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BETWEEN_LINKS     Specifies whether a "br/" is inserted between two links     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_NEWLINE_BETW_LINK_AND_TAG Specifies whether a "br" is inserted between a link and tag .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_OFFLINE_BROWSING_SUPPORTEDSpecifies whether cached pages can be browsed offline       .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_OFFLINE_FORMS_SUPPORTED   Specifies whether forms can be filled offline               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_PAGE_SIZE_MAX             Returns the maximum size of a page                          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_PAGE_SIZE_REMAINING       Returns the number of rem. bytes for the remaining control  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_PIXEL_HEIGHT              Returns the screen height in pixels                         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_PIXEL_WIDTH               Returns the screen width in pixels                          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_REDIR_ABSOLUTE_SUPPORTED  Specifies whether an absolute URL can be diverted           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_REDIR_RELATIVE_SUPPORTED  Specifies whether a relative URL can be diverted            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SCRIPT_SUPPORTED          Specifies whether the Browser supports scripting            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SCRIPT_VERSION            Returns the script version that is supported                .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SECURE_PROTOCOLS_SUPPORTEDSpecifies whether secure protocols are supported            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SECURE_PROTOCOL_NAMES     Returns the name of the security protocol that is supported .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SELECTION_MENU_SUPPORTED  Specifies wehter a menu with numbering is supported         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SELF_HREF                 No longer supported                                         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SETVAR_ON_EVENT_SUPPORTED Specifies whether "setvar" is possible without "onevent"    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SKIPPING_TO_INPUT         Specifies if automatic lead at first "input" tag            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SMALL_SUPPORTED           Specifies whether text can be formatted as small            .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOFTKEYS_RENDERED_INLINE  Specifies whether soft keys are displayed as buttons        .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOFTKEY_NUM               Returns the number of supported soft keys on the device     .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOFTKEY_STYLE1            Describes how soft key 1 is displayed on the screen         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOFTKEY_STYLE2            Describes how soft key 2 is displayed on the screen         .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOFTKEY_TITLE_WIDTH       Returns the max. length of the soft key label               .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SOUND_SUPPORTED           Specifies whether the end device can process tones          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_STRONG_SUPPORTED          Specifies whether text can be formatted as highlighted      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SUBMIT_ONEVENT_SUPPORTED  Specifies whether submit within "onevent" is supported      .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_SUB_CATEGORY              Is used to group end devices                                .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TABLE_HAS_BORDERS         Specifies whether tables are displayed with gridlines       .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TABLE_SUPPORTED           Specifies whether the browser supports multi-column tables  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TELEPHONY_LINKS_SUPPORTED Specifies if phone numbers can be directly dialled via link .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TEXT_ALIGNMENT_SUPPORTED  Specifies whether text alignment is possible within e. para..
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TEXT_STYLES_SUPPORTED     Specifies whether text formatting using "b" etc. is possible.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TITLE_SUPPORTED           Specifies if he title attribute of "card" tag is visible    .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_TITLE_WIDTH               Returns the max. character number of the title              .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_UNDERLINE_SUPPORTED       Describes whether text can be formatted underlined          .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_USER_AGENT                Corresponds to the HTTP request header USER AGENT           .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_VARS_ACROSS_CARD_SUPPORTEDSpecifies if Browser variables are poss. for different cards.
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_VENDOR                    Returns the name of the device manufacturer                 .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_XSL_SUPPORTED             Specifies whether the Browser supports XSL                  .
IF_CLIENT_INFO                 I GET_XSL_VERSION               Returns the XSL version that is supported                   .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I ACTIVATE_ENTRIES              Activates Inactive Log Entries                              .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I DELETE                        Delete All Log Entries                                      .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I DELETE_ENTRIES                Deletes Selected Log Entries                                .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I GET_ENTRIES                   Delivers Log Entries                                        .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I GET_FOR_VERSION               Get Customer Modification Log to Create a Version           .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I GET_NOTE_ENTRIES              Returns Log Entries of Corrections to Notes                 .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I INSERT_ENTRIES                Adds Log Entries                                            .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I MODIFY_ENTRIES                Updates Selected Log Entries and Adds New Entries           .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I MOVE_ENTRIES                  Deletes Entries and Adds them to New Transport Object       .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I RESET                         Resets Logs to Original                                     .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION       Deletes All Inactive Log Entries                            .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I SAVE                          Writes and Deletes Log Entries in the Database              .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I SAVE_FROM_VERSION             Save Data from Version Management                           .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I SAVE_INTERMEDIATE_VERSION     Save Current Status of Upgrade Adjustment                   .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I SAVE_UPGRADE_MODE             Saves the Adjustment Mode for Single Log Entries            .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I SET_UPGRADE_MODE              Sets Comparison Mode for Each Log Entry                     .
IF_CLM_TOOL_LOG                I UPDATE_ENTRIES                Updates Selected Log Entries                                .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I EXECUTE_ITEMS_CMD             Execute command                                             .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I EXECUTE_LINKS_CMD             Execute command                                             .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I GET_CMD_FOR_ITEMS             Command for One or Several Browser Items                    .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I GET_CMD_FOR_LINKS             Command for One or Several Browser Links                    .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I GET_MENU_BUTTON_COMMANDS      Delivers Commands for Dynamic Construction of Context Menu  .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I SET_BROWSER_CMD_FOR_ITEMS     Set Permitted Browser-Specific Commands                     .
IF_CMD_HANDLER                 I SET_BROWSER_CMD_FOR_LINKS     Set Permitted Browser-Specific Commands                     .
IF_CMPD_ASSIGNMENT_MERGE       I MERGE                         Merge Old and New Status                                    .
IF_CMPD_ASSIGNMENT_MERGE       I SUBITEM_BEFORE_DETERMINATION  What is to be copied from the main item?                    .
IF_CMPD_ASSIGNMENT_MERGE       I SUBITEM_NO_DETERMINATION      What is to be copied from the main item?                    .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_DATAPOINT_PATH_INFO       Gets Information about Data Point Address                   .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_DATAPOINT_PATH_LIST       Gets Addresses that Match Search Pattern for Data Points    .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_DATAPOINT_PATH_STATE      Only Gets Status for Address of a Data Point                .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_EVENT_PATH_INFO           Gets Information about Event Address                        .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_EVENT_PATH_LIST           Gets Addresses that Match Search Pattern for Events         .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I GET_EVENT_PATH_STATE          Gets Status for Address of an Event                         .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I NAVIGATE_DATAPOINT_DEFINITION Navigation to Maintenance Environment of Data Point         .
IF_CMX_DA_ASSISTANT            I NAVIGATE_EVENT_DEFINITION     Navigation to Maintenance Environment of Event              .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_ADDRESS_DATAPOINT          Build for Data Point: Address                               .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_ADDRESS_EVENT              Build for Event: Address                                    .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_EVENT_ACCESS               Build for Event Access                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_EVENT_BEGIN                Build for Event: Start                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_EVENT_END                  Build for Event: End                                        .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_ITEM_BEGIN                 Build for List Entry: Start                                 .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_ITEM_END                   Build for List Entry: End                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_LIST_BEGIN                 Build or List: Start                                        .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_LIST_END                   Build for List: End                                         .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_MESSAGE_RETCODE            Build for Message: Return Code                              .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_MESSAGE_TEXT               Build for Message: Text                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_MESSAGE_TYPE               Build for Message: SY Fields                                .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_REQUEST_BEGIN              Build for Request: Start                                    .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_REQUEST_END                Build for Request: End                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_RESPONSE_BEGIN             Build for Response: Start                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_RESPONSE_END               Build for Response: End                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_DATE                 Build for Value: Date                                       .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_FLOAT                Build for Value: Floating Point Number                      .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_INTEGER              Build for Value: Integer                                    .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_NUMC                 Build for Value: Numeric Character String                   .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_PACKED               Build for Value: Packed Number                              .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_STRING               Build for Value: String                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_STRUCTURE            Build for Value: Structure                                  .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_TABLE                Build for Value: Table                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_TIME                 Build for Value: Time                                       .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_TIMESTAMPL           Build for Value: Time Stamp (Date & Time)                   .
IF_CMX_DA_BUILDER              I AT_VALUE_XSTRING              Build for Value: Byte String                                .
IF_CMX_DA_CLIENT               I COMPLETE_PROCESSING           Complete Processing; All Data Was Transferred               .
IF_CMX_DA_CLIENT               I HANDLE_EVENT                  Handle Event Occurred                                       .
IF_CMX_DA_CLIENT               I HANDLE_RESPONSE               Process Result of Request                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I EXT_TO_EVENT                  Creates Event Object from External Object (Director)        .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I EXT_TO_RESPONSE               Creates Response Object from External Object (Director)     .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I XML_FROM_EVENT                Creates XML Document from Event Object (MDA Schema)         .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I XML_FROM_RESPONSE             Creates XML Document from Response Object (MDA Schema)      .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I XML_TO_EVENT                  Creats Event Object from XML Document (MDA Schema)          .
IF_CMX_DA_CONVERTER            I XML_TO_RESPONSE               Creates Response Object from XML Document (MDA Schema)      .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I BROWSE_DATAPOINTS             Browse for Data Points                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I BROWSE_EVENTS                 Browse for Events                                           .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I CHECK_DATAPOINT               Checks Address for Single Document                          .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I CHECK_EVENT                   Checks Address for Single Event                             .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I GET_DATAPOINTS                Gets Data Points Valid for Search Pattern                   .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I GET_DATAPOINT_STATE           Gets Status of Data Point                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I GET_EVENTS                    Gets Events Valid for Search Pattern                        .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I GET_EVENT_STATE               Gets Status of Event                                        .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I GET_SERVICES                  Gets Active Services for Search Pattern                     .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I NAVIGATE_DATAPOINT_DEFINITION Navigation to Maintenance Environment of Data Point         .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I NAVIGATE_EVENT_DEFINITION     Navigation to Maintenance Environment of Event              .
IF_CMX_DA_DICTIONARY           I UPDATE_ADDRESS_BUFFER         Updates Status of Addresses Checked                         .
IF_CMX_DA_DIRECTOR             I CALL_BUILDER                  Call Builder with Own Data                                  .
IF_CMX_DA_EVENT                I GET_ADDRESS                   Gets Event Address                                          .
IF_CMX_DA_EVENT                I GET_ITEMS                     Gets Parameters and Messages                                .
IF_CMX_DA_EVENT                I GET_NAME                      Gets Event Name (Address)                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_EVENT                I GET_SERVER                    Gets Server that Created Event Object                       .
IF_CMX_DA_EVENT                I GET_SUBSCRIPTION              Gets Subscription ID (with Dynamic Activation)              .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_ADDRESS_OF_DATAPOINT   Creates Address Object for Data Point                       .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_ADDRESS_OF_EVENT       Creates Address Object for Event                            .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_CONVERTER              Creates Converter                                           .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_EVENT                  Creates Event Object                                        .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_EVENT_ASYNC            Creates Event Object with Asynchronous Processing           .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_MESSAGE_WITH_EXCEPTION Creates Message for Exception                               .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_MESSAGE_WITH_RETCODE   Creates Message for Return Value                            .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_MESSAGE_WITH_TEXT      Creates Message for Short Text                              .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_MESSAGE_WITH_TYPE      Creates Message with ABAP Structure                         .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_REQUEST                Creates Request Object                                      .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_RESPONSE               Creates Response Object                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_RESPONSE_ASYNC         Creates Response Object with Asynchronous Responses         .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_DATE        Creates Value from Date                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_FLOAT       Creates Value from Floating Point Number                    .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_INTEGER     Creates Value from Integer                                  .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_NUMC        Creates Value from Numeric Character String                 .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_PACKED      Creates Value from Packed Number                            .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_STRING      Creates Value from String                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_STRUCTURE   Creates Value from Structure                                .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_TABLE       Creates Value from Standard Table                           .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_TIME        Creates Value from Time                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_TIMESTAMPL  Creates Value from Time Stamp (Date & Time)                 .
IF_CMX_DA_FACTORY              I CREATE_VALUE_FROM_XSTRING     Creates Value from Byte String                              .
IF_CMX_DA_LOG                  I WRITE                         Write Entries                                               .
IF_CMX_DA_MESSAGE              I GET_AS_TEXT                   Gets Simple Text                                            .
IF_CMX_DA_MESSAGE              I GET_AS_TYPE                   Gets ABAP Message                                           .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I DISCARD                       Clear Instance                                              .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I GET_CLIENT                    Gets Client for which Request Was Created                   .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I GET_HANDLE                    Gets Unique ID for Instance                                 .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I GET_ITEMS                     Gets Tasks for Server                                       .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I GET_STATE                     Gets Current Status                                         .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I GET_USER                      Gets System User who Created Request                        .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I SUBMIT                        Close and Send Instance                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_REQUEST              I WAIT                          Instance to Wait for Asynchronous Response                  .
IF_CMX_DA_RESPONSE             I APPEND_RESPONSE               Add Further Response Objects                                .
IF_CMX_DA_RESPONSE             I GET_ITEMS                     Gets Entries                                                .
IF_CMX_DA_RESPONSE             I GET_REQUEST                   Gets Initiating Request                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_RESPONSE             I GET_REQUEST_HANDLE            Gets Handle of Initiating Request                           .
IF_CMX_DA_RESPONSE             I GET_SERVER                    Gets Server that Created Response Object                    .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVER               I CANCEL_REQUEST                Cancel Processing of Asynchronous Request                   .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVER               I GET_ASYNC_RESPONSES           Get Asynchronously Provided Data                            .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVER               I GET_EVENT_OBJECTS             Get Asynchronously Created Event Objects                    .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVER               I HANDLE_EVENT_ACCESS           Perform Access to Events                                    .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVER               I HANDLE_REQUEST                Adopt and Process Request                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVICE              I GET_ASSISTANT                 Gets Assistant                                              .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVICE              I GET_CLIENT                    Gets Client                                                 .
IF_CMX_DA_SERVICE              I GET_SERVER                    Gets Server                                                 .
IF_CMX_DA_SESSION              I FREE_LOG                      Switch Off Logging                                          .
IF_CMX_DA_SESSION              I INIT_LOG                      Switch On Logging                                           .
IF_CMX_DA_SESSION              I PING_LOG                      Address Logging via Connected Sessions                      .
IF_CMX_DA_SESSION              I QUERY_ASYNC_RESPONSES         Starts Transfer of Asynchronously Provided Data             .
IF_CMX_DA_SESSION              I QUERY_EVENTS                  Starts Transfer of Events                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_UNKNOWN              I QUERY_INTERFACE               Query Special Interface                                     .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_DATE                   Gets Value as Date                                          .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_FLOAT                  Gets Value as Floating Point Number                         .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_INTEGER                Gets Value as Integer                                       .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_REFERENCE              Gets Value as Data Reference                                .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_STRING                 Gets Value as Character String                              .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_TIME                   Gets Value as Time                                          .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_TIMESTAMPL             Gets Value as Time Stamp                                    .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_AS_XSTRING                Gets Value as Byte String                                   .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_INTO_NUMC                 Puts Value into Field for Numeric Character Strings         .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_INTO_PACKED               Puts Value into Field for Packed Number                     .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_INTO_STRUCTURE            Puts Value into Structure of Character Type (C, N, D, T)    .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_INTO_TABLE                Puts Value into Internal Table                              .
IF_CMX_DA_VALUE                I GET_TYPE                      Gets Data Type of Value Managed                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_CALCULATION            Nodes Generated for Definition of Calculations              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_CONSTANT               Generate Node for a Constant (Ident)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_DATA_ACCESS            Nodes Generated for Data Access Output                      .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_DATA_AUTOMATIC         Nodes Generated for Automatic Determination of Creation Date.
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_DATA_POINT             Generate Node for a Data Point                              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_DATA_REQUEST_SIMPLE    Generated Nodes for a Simple Data Request                   .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_DATA_TABLE             Nodes Generated for Output/Input of Data Table              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_EVENT                  Generate Node for an Event                                  .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_EVT_FORMULA            Generate Node for a Formula as Event Trigger                .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_EVT_FUNCTION           Generate Node for a Function as Event Trigger               .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_EXTERNAL               Generate Node for an External Value (Process Message Type)  .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_FIX                    Generates Nodes for a Fixed Value                           .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_FUNCTION               Nodes Generated for a Function Call                         .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_DATE             Nodes Generated for Date Entry                              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_FIELD            Nodes Generated for Single Value Entry                      .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_FIELD_TEXT       Nodes Generated for Text Entry                              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_NUMBER           Nodes Generated for Number Entry                            .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_PARAM            Generated Nodes for Entry of a Parameter                    .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_SIGNATURE        Nodes Generated for Signature Entry                         .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_INPUT_TIME             Nodes Generated for Time Entry                              .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_MESSAGE                Nodes Generated for a Process Message                       .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_NODE                   Nodes Generated                                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_DATE            Nodes Generated for Date Output                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_FIELD           Nodes Generated for Single Value Output                     .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_FIELD_TEXT      Nodes Generated for Text Output                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_IMAGE           Nodes Generated for Graphic Output                          .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_LINK            Nodes Generated for Hyperlink Output                        .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_NUMBER          Nodes Generated for Number Output                           .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_OBJECT          Nodes Generated for Object Output                           .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_PARAM           Generated Nodes for Output of a Parameter                   .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_OUTPUT_TIME            Nodes Generated for Time Output                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_PARAMETER              Generate Node for a Parameter                               .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_SYSTEM_COMMAND         Nodes Generated for a Command                               .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_VALIDATION             Generate Node for an Input Value Check                      .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_VAL_FORMULA            Generate Node for a Value Check Formula                     .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_VAL_FUNCTION           Generate Node for a Value Check Function                    .
IF_CMX_PII_FACTORY             I CREATE_VARIABLE               Generate Node for a Variable                                .
IF_CMX_PII_FUNCTION            I ADD_PARAM                     Add Reference to Parameter Node                             .
IF_CMX_PII_FUNCTION            I GET_FUNC_NAME                 Method of Accessing Attribute NAME (read)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_FUNCTION            I GET_PARAM                     Access Method for Reference Table of Parameter Node (Read)  .
IF_CMX_PII_FUNCTION            I REMOVE_PARAM                  Method of Accessing Ref. Table of Parameter Nodes (Delete)  .
IF_CMX_PII_FUNCTION            I SET_FUNC_NAME                 Method of Accessing Attribute NAME (write)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE                I CALL_VISITOR                  Method of Node that Visitor Receives                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_AUTOMATIC      I GET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Read)         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_AUTOMATIC      I SET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Write)        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I ADD_CALC_FORMULA              Adds Formula Part to Internal Formula Table                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I ADD_TRIGGER                   Methods of Accessing Trigger (Write)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I GET_CALC_FORMULA              Returns Complete Formula                                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I GET_CALC_FORMULA_TAB          Provides Fragments of the Formula                           .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I GET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I GET_TRIGGER                   Method of Accessing Trigger (read)                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I GET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Read)         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I REMOVE_CALC_FORMULA           Deletes the Internal Formula Table                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I SET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_CALCULATION    I SET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Write)        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_COMMAND        I GET_ACTION_TYPE               Access Method for Action Attribute Type (read)              .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_COMMAND        I SET_ACTION_TYPE               Access Method for Action Attribute Type (write)             .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_COMMAND        I SET_TRIGGER                   Adopt Trigger                                               .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVENT          I GET_EVENT_NAME                Access Method for NAME Attribute (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVENT          I SET_EVENT_NAME                Access Method for NAME Attribute (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FORMULA    I ADD_FORMULA                   Adds Formula Part to Formula Table                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FORMULA    I GET_FORMULA                   Returns Complete Formula                                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FORMULA    I GET_FORMULA_TAB               Returns Formula Fragments                                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FORMULA    I REMOVE_FORMULA                Deletes the Internal Formula Table                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FUNCTION   I ADD_PARAM                     Add Reference to Parameter Node                             .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EVT_FUNCTION   I GET_PARAM                     Access Method for Reference Table of Parameter Node (Read)  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EXTERNAL       I GET_DEFAULT                   Access Method for Attribute DEFAULT (Read)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_EXTERNAL       I SET_DEFAULT                   Access Method for Attribute DEFAULT (Write)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I GET_URL                       Access Method for Attribute URL (Read)                      .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I GET_VALUE                     Access Method for Attribute VALUE (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I GET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Read)         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I SET_URL                       Access Method for Attribute URL (Write)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I SET_VALUE                     Access Method for Attribute VALUE (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FIX            I SET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Write)        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I GET_BUTTON_TEXT               Access Method for Attribute TEXT (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I GET_DISPLAY                   Access Method for Attribute DISPLAY (Read)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I GET_TRIGGER                   Method for Accessing Attribute TRIGGER (Read)               .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I SET_BUTTON_TEXT               Access Method for Attribute TEXT (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I SET_DISPLAY                   Access Method for Attribute DISPLAY (Write)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FUNCTION       I SET_TRIGGER                   Method for Accessing for Attribute TRIGGER (Write)          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FWD_VARDECL    I GET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_FWD_VARDECL    I SET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I GET_IDENT_NAME                Access Method for NAME Attribute (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I GET_PARAM                     Access Method for Reference to Parameter Node (Read)        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I GET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I SET_IDENT_NAME                Access Method for NAME Attribute (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I SET_PARAM                     Access Method for Reference to Parameter Node (Write)       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_IDENT          I SET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I GET_CONFIRMATION              Access Method for Reference to Step Signature  (Read)       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I GET_DEFAULT                   Access Method for Attributes DEFAULT_VALUE and DEFAULT_TYPE .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I GET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I GET_VALIDATION                Access Method for Referenece to Check Node (Read)           .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I GET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Read)         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I SET_CONFIRMATION              Access Method for Reference to Step Signature  (Write)      .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I SET_DEFAULT                   Access Method for Attributes DEFAULT_VALUE and DEFAULT_TYPE .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I SET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I SET_VALIDATION                Access Method for Reference to Check Node (Write)           .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_INPUT          I SET_VARIABLE                  Access Method for Reference to Variable Node (Write)        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_OUTPUT         I GET_FIX                       Access Method for Fixed Valuation (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_OUTPUT         I GET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_OUTPUT         I SET_FIX                       Access Method for Fixed Valuation (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_OUTPUT         I SET_LABEL                     Access Method for Attribute LABEL (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I GET_IDENT                     Access Method for Reference to Identifier Node (Read)       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I GET_OPTIONAL                  Access Method for Attribute OPTIONAL (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I GET_PARAM_NAME                Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I GET_PARAM_TYPE                Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I SET_IDENT                     Access Method to Reference to Identifier Node (Write)       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I SET_OPTIONAL                  Access Method to Attribute OPTIONAL (Write)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I SET_PARAM_NAME                Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PARAMETER      I SET_PARAM_TYPE                Access Method for Attribute TYPE (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I GET_CURR_BLOCK                Access Method for Attribut BLOCK (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I GET_NO                        Access Method for Attribute NO (Read)                       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I GET_PREDECESSOR               Access Method for Attribute PREDECESSOR (Read)              .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I INSERT_PREDECESSOR            Access Method for Attribute PREDECESSOR (Write)             .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I SET_CURR_BLOCK                Access Method for Attribut BLOCK (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PHASE          I SET_NO                        Access Method for Attribute NO (Write)                      .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_CATEGORY                  Access Method for Attribute CATEGORY (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_ERROR_LOG                 Access Method for Attribute ERROR_LOG (Read)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_FTLNR                     Access Method for Attribute NO (Read)                       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_FTNO                      Access Method for Attribute FTNO (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_LAYOUT_URL                Access Method for Attribute LAYOUT_URL (Read)               .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_MAX_SIZE                  Access Method for Attribute MAX_SIZE (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_MIN_SIZE                  Access Method for Attribute MIN_SIZE (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_SYMBOLS                   Access Method for Attribute SYMBOLS (Read)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I GET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute REPEATED (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_CATEGORY                  Access Method for Attribute CATEGORY (Write)++              .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_ERROR_LOG                 Access Method for Attribute ERROR_LOG (Write)               .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_FTLNR                     Access Method for Attribute NO (Write)                      .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_FTNO                      Access Method for Attribute FTNO (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_LAYOUT_URL                Access Method for Attribute LAYOUT_URL (Write)              .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_MAX_SIZE                  Access Method for Attribute MAX_SIZE (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_MIN_SIZE                  Access Method for Attribute MIN_SIZE (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_SYMBOLS                   Access Method for Attribute SYMBOLS (Write)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PI             I SET_TYPE                      Access Method for Attribute REPEATED (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PROCESS_STEP   I ADD_STEP                      Inserts Object in Quantity of Referen. Step Objects (Write) .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PROCESS_STEP   I GET_PARENT                    Access Method for Parent (Read)                             .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PROCESS_STEP   I GET_STEP                      Access Method for Reference Table (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PROCESS_STEP   I REMOVE_STEP                   Method of Accessing Reference Table (Delete)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_PROCESS_STEP   I SET_PARENT                    Access Method for Parent (Write)                            .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I ADD_STEP                      Adds Reference to Step Object to Reference Table            .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_LAYOUT                    Access Method for LAYOUT Attribute (Read)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_LOCATION                  Access Method for PLANT Attribute (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_METADATA                  Access Method for METADATA Attribute (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_RECIPE_NAME               Accessing Method for Attribute Document Name (read)         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_SETTINGS                  Access Method for SETTINGS Attribute (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I GET_STEP                      Access Method to Reference Table (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I SET_LAYOUT                    Access Method for LAYOUT Attribute (Write)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I SET_LOCATION                  Access Method for PLANT Attribute (Write)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I SET_METADATA                  Access Method for METADATA Attribute (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I SET_RECIPE_NAME               Access Method for Attribute Document Name (Write)           .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_RECIPE         I SET_SETTINGS                  Access Method for SETTINGS Attribute (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_REQUEST        I GET_REQUEST_NAME              Access Method for NAME Attribute (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_REQUEST        I SET_REQUEST_NAME              Access Method for NAME Attribute (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFORM        I ADD_VAL_FORMULA               Adds Formula Term to the Formula Table (Write)              .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFORM        I GET_VAL_FORMULA               Delivers the Complete Formula (Read)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFORM        I GET_VAL_FORMULA_TAB           Delivers the Formula in Fragments (Read)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFORM        I REMOVE_VAL_FORMULA            Deletes the Internal Formula Table                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFUNC        I GET_FUNC_NAME                 Access Method for NAME Attribute (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALFUNC        I SET_FUNC_NAME                 Access Method for NAME Attribute (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I GET_ACCEPT                    Access Method for Attribute ACCEPT (Read)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I GET_SIG_AUTH                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_AUTH (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I GET_SIG_MODE                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_MODE (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I GET_SIG_STRA                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_STRA (Read)                 .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I GET_TEXT                      Access Method for Attribute TEXT (Read)                     .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I SET_ACCEPT                    Access Method for Attribute ACCEPT (Write)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I SET_SIG_AUTH                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_AUTH (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I SET_SIG_MODE                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_MODE (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I SET_SIG_STRA                  Access Method for Attribute SIG_STRA (Write)                .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VALIDATION     I SET_TEXT                      Access Method for Attribute TEXT (Write)                    .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VARIABLE       I GET_GLOBAL                    Access Method for Attribute GLOBAL (Read)                   .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_VARIABLE       I SET_GLOBAL                    Access Method for Attribute GLOBAL (Write)                  .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I ADD_PARAM                     Access Method for Parameter (Write)                         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I ADD_PREDECESSOR               Access Method for Predecessor (Read)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I GET_ID                        Access Method for an XStep ID (Read)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I GET_LIVE_STATE                Access Method for Live State (Read)                         .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I GET_PARAM                     Access Method for Parameter (Read)                          .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I GET_PREDECESSOR               Access Method for Predecessor (Write)                       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I GET_REF_ID                    Access Method for a Reference XStep ID (Read)               .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I SET_ID                        Access Method for an XStep ID (Write)                       .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I SET_LIVE_STATE                Access Method for Live State (Write)                        .
IF_CMX_PII_NODE_XS_STEP        I SET_REF_ID                    Access Method for a Reference XStep ID (Write)              .
IF_CMX_PII_RECIPE              I CHECK                         Check Semantics                                             .
IF_CMX_PII_RECIPE              I GENERATE                      Generate PI Sheet                                           .
IF_CMX_PII_RECIPE              I SIMULATE                      Simulate PI Sheet                                           .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I CHECK_SEMANTIC                Executes the Semantic Check                                 .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I GENERATE_PI_SHEET             Executes the PI Sheet Generator                             .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I GENERATE_XML                  Executes the XML Generator                                  .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I PARSE                         Executes the Parser                                         .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I RENDER                        Executes the Renderer                                       .
IF_CMX_PII_RUNTIME             I START_AUTO_CORRECTION         Carries Out Automatic Correction                            .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_AUTOMATIC               Visitor Method for Automatic Value Assignment Node          .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_CALCULATION             Visitor Method for Calculation Node                         .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_CHAR                    Visitor Method for Characteristic Node                      .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_COMMAND                 Visitor Method for Command                                  .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_CONST                   Visitor Method for Constant Node                            .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_DATAPOINT               Visitor Method for Data Point                               .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_DATA_ACCESS             Visitor Method for Manufacturing Data Access                .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_EVENT                   Visitor Method for Conditions (Event)                       .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_EVT_FORMULA             Visitor Method for Condition Formula                        .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_EVT_FUNCTION            Visitor Method for Condition Function                       .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_EXTERNAL                Visitor Method for External Value Assignment Node           .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_FIX                     Visitor Method for Fixed Value Assignment Node              .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_FUNCTION                Visitor Method for Function Node                            .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_FWD_VARDECL             Visitor Method for Forwards Declaration Node                .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_INPUT                   Visitor Method for Input Node                               .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_MESSAGE                 Visitor Method for Destination Node                         .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_OUTPUT_CHAR             Visitor Method for Output Characteristic Node               .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_OUTPUT_VAR              Visitor Method for Output Variable Node                     .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_PARAM                   Visitor Method for Parameter Node                           .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_PHASE                   Visitor Method for Phase Node                               .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_PI                      Visitor Method for Process Instruction Node                 .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_RECIPE                  Visitor Method for Recipe Node                              .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_VALFORM                 Visitor Method for Check Formula Node                       .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_VALFUNC                 Visitor Method for Check Function Node                      .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_VALIDATION              Visitor Method for Check Node                               .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_VARIABLE                Visitor Method for Variable Node                            .
IF_CMX_PII_VISITOR             I VISIT_XS_STEP                 Visitor Method for XStep                                    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_AGENT             I GET_VALUES_LARGE              Gets Data Records in DB LARGE Format for GUIDs              .
IF_CMX_TYPES_AGENT             I GET_VALUES_MEDIUM             Gets Data Records in DB MEDIUM Format for GUIDs             .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I GET_DOMAIN_BY_ID              Gets a Domain Object for ID                                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I GET_DOMAIN_BY_NAME            Gets a Domain Object for Name                               .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I GET_DOMAIN_FORMATS            Gets a List of Defined Domain Formats                       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I GET_DOMAIN_GROUPS             Gets a List of Released Domain Groups                       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I GET_DOMAIN_LIST               Gets a List of Released Domains                             .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I PRELOAD_DOMAIN_GROUP          Loads all Domains for Group                                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DICTIONARY        I REFRESH_DOMAIN_BUFFER         Updates all Domains Loaded                                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I BROWSE_HELP_VALUES            SCREEN: Displays the Input Help                             .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I BROWSE_ONLINE_HELP            SCREEN: Displays the Online Documentation                   .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_DATE                Converts Data Format in Internal Display                    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_DISPLAY             Converts Screen Format in Internal Display                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_FLOAT               Converts Floating Point Number in Internal Display          .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_INTEGER             Converts Integer in Internal Display                        .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_MDA                 Converts MDA Value in Internal Display                      .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_NUMC                Converts Numeric Character String in Internal Display       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_PACKED              Converts Packed Number in Internal Display                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_STRING              Converts Character String in Internal Display               .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_STRUCTURE           Converts Structure in Internal Display                      .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_TABLE               Converts Table in Internal Display                          .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_TEXT                Converts SAPscript Text Into Internal Display               .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_TIME                Converts Time Format in Internal Display                    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_VALUE               Converts Interal Display from Another Domain                .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_FROM_XSTRING             Converts Byte Sequence in Internal Display                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_DATE                Converts Internal Display in Date Format                    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_DISPLAY             Converts Internal Display in Screen Format                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_FLOAT               Converts Internal Display in Floating Number                .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_INTEGER             Converts Internal Display in Integer                        .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_MDA                 Converts Internal Display in MDA Value                      .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_NUMC                Converts Internal Display in Numeric Character String       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_PACKED              Converts Internal Display in Packed Number                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_STRING              Converts Internal Display in Character String               .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_STRUCTURE           Converts Internal Display in Structure                      .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_TABLE               Converts Internal Display in Table                          .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_TEXT                Converts Internal Display in SAPscript Text                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_TIME                Converts Internal Display in Time Format                    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I CONV_INTO_XSTRING             Converts Internal Display in Byte Sequence                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_CT_FORMAT                 Gets Corresponding CT Basic Format                          .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_DECIMALS                  Gets the Defined Number of Decimal Places                   .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Description (Language-Dependent)                       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_FORMAT                    Gets Basic Format                                           .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_HELP_VALUES               Gets Permitted Constant Values (Language-Dependent)         .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_LENGTH                    Gets the Defined Length for Internal Display                .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_MIMETYPE                  Gets the Permitted Mimetype                                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I GET_SIZE                      Gets the Defined Output Length                              .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I HAS_HELP_VALUES_ONLY          Are the Permitted Fixed Values Allowed Only?                .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I HAS_VALUE_HELP                Is Input Help Available                                     .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I REFRESH                       Updates the Internal Data                                   .
IF_CMX_TYPES_DOMAIN            I VALIDATE                      Checks a Value                                              .
IF_CMX_TYPES_PROVIDER          I DISCARD_DOMAIN                Discards a Domain that has Already been Loaded              .
IF_CMX_TYPES_PROVIDER          I LOAD_DOMAIN_BY_ID             Loads a Domain by ID                                        .
IF_CMX_TYPES_PROVIDER          I LOAD_DOMAIN_BY_NAME           Loads a Domain by Name                                      .
IF_CMX_TYPES_PROVIDER          I LOAD_DOMAIN_GROUP             Loads a Domain Group                                        .
IF_CMX_TYPES_PROVIDER          I REFRESH_BUFFER                Updates all Domains Loaded                                  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CHECK_MIMETYPE                Checks an Entered Mime Type                                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CHECK_VALUES_CONTEXT          Executes a Context Check for Values in API Format           .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_BUFFER_TO_DB             Converts Values from Runtime Format in DB Delta             .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_DB_TO_BUFFER             Converts Values from DB Format in Runtime Format            .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_DB_TO_COPY               Converts Values from DB Format in DB Copy                   .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_DB_TO_DELETE             Converts Values from DB Format in DB Format                 .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_STRING_TO_VALUE          Converts an ASCII Text into Internal Value Format           .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_TEXT_TO_VALUE            Converts a SAP Script Text in to the Internal Value Format  .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_VALUE                    Converts a Value when Exchanging the Assigned Domains       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_VALUE_TO_HTML            Converts a Value in Internal Format to HTML Text            .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_VALUE_TO_STRING          Converts a Value in Internal Format to ASCII Text           .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CONV_VALUE_TO_TEXT            Converts a Value in Internal Format to SAP Scipt Text       .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I CREATE_VALUE_GUID             Generates a GUID for Values in DB Format MEDIUM or LARGE    .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I GET_EDITOR_TYPE               Gets the Editor Type for Mime Type of a Domain              .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I GET_SUPPORTED_MIMETYPES       Gets the Supported Mime Types for the Domain Format         .
IF_CMX_TYPES_UTILITY           I REPLACE_VALUE_SYMBOLS         Replaces Symbols in Values; &SYMBOL& or SAPScript-          .
IF_CMX_XSE_APPLICATION         I CREATE_NODE_CUSTOM            Generates a New Custom Node for Applicat. of Specified Type .
IF_CMX_XSE_APPLICATION         I CREATE_NODE_ROOT              Generates a New Root Node                                   .
IF_CMX_XSE_APPLICATION         I ON_DISPLAY_CONTEXT            Recall for Entry Context Node Request                       .
IF_CMX_XSE_APPLICATION         I ON_DISPLAY_ENTRY              Recall for Access Node Request                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_APPLICATION         I ON_UPDATE_SETTINGS            Recall for Update of Settings                               .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I CREATE_NODE_CUSTOM            Creates a New Node Without Insert: Custom Type              .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I CREATE_NODE_RUNTIME           Creates a New Node Without Insert: Runtime Type             .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I CREATE_NODE_SIMPLE            Creates a New Node Without Insert: Every Type               .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_APPLICATION_COMMANDS      Gets Application-Specific Commands                          .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_APPLICATION_CONTEXT       Gets the Highest Context Nodes of the Application           .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_APPLICATION_LOCATION      Gets the Location of the Application if Defined             .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_APPLICATION_NAME          Gets the Name of the Application                            .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_APPLICATION_TITLE         Gets the Title Text of the Application                      .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_COMMON_ANCESTOR           Gets the Next Shared, Superordinated Node                   .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_CUSTOM_NODE_FROM_SELECTIONDelivers the Superordinated XSX Custom Node for Selection   .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_DEBUG_MODE                Gets the Current Display Mode for Technical Details         .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_DESTINATION_TYPE          Gets the Assgined Destination Type for the Node             .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_DRAGDROP_BEHAVIOUR        Gets the Drag and Drop Behavior Object for the Node Type    .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_DRAGDROP_ID               Gets the Drag and Drop Behavior Handle for the Node Type    .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_EDIT_MODE                 Gets the Actual Process Mode for the Chosen Node            .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_ENTRY_NODES               Gets the Access Nodes for the Application                   .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_EXCLUDED_COMMANDS         Gets the Deactivated Commands                               .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_MESSAGE_BUFFER            Gets all Data for Update of Message Output                  .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_PLUGIN                    Gets a Loaded Plugin                                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_ROOT_FROM_SELECTION       Gets the Superordinated Root for Selection                  .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_SELECTED_DESTINATION      Gets the Destination Currently Selected                     .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Gets the Actual Node Selection                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_SELECTED_SIMULATION       Gets the Simulation Copy for the Current Selection          .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_SIMULATOR                 Gets a Loaded Simulation Plugin                             .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_STEP_FROM_SELECTION       Gets the Superordinated Step for Selection                  .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I GET_XML_FROM_SELECTION        Gets the XML Data for Selected Nodes                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I PASTE_NODES_FROM_XML          Inserts Nodes After Conversion from XML                     .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I PASTE_NODES_SIMPLE            Inserts a List of Nodes (Clipboard, Drag&Drop)              .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I POPUP_TO_CONFIRM              Displays a Dialog Box as Confirmation                       .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I SET_COMMAND_CANCELED          Changes the Status of the Current Command: Canceled         .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I SET_COMMAND_COMPLETED         Changes the Status of the Current Command: Executed         .
IF_CMX_XSE_CONTROLLER          I SET_SELECTED_NODES            Sets the Actual Node Selection                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_EDITOR              I LEAVE                         Starts the Exit Routine of the Editor                       .
IF_CMX_XSE_EDITOR              I RESET                         Updates the Settings and Initializes the Display            .
IF_CMX_XSE_EDITOR              I SELECT                        Selects the Transferred Nodes if this is Possible           .
IF_CMX_XSE_EDITOR              I START                         Starts the Display of the Editor                            .
IF_CMX_XSE_EDITOR              I UPDATE                        Updates the Settings                                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_FRAME               I SET_HIDDEN                    Hides a Subordinated Component                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_FRAME               I SET_VISIBLE                   Shows a Subordinated Component                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_INLINE              I GET_SETTINGS                  Delivers the Settings for the Components                    .
IF_CMX_XSE_INLINE              I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets the Actual GUI-Container for the Components            .
IF_CMX_XSE_INLINE              I SET_HIDDEN                    Sets the Components to Non-Visible                          .
IF_CMX_XSE_INLINE              I SET_PARENT                    Sets the Supordinated Components                            .
IF_CMX_XSE_INLINE              I SET_VISIBLE                   Sets the Components to Visible                              .
IF_CMX_XSE_INTERACTIVE         I DO_COMMAND                    Handles a Command                                           .
IF_CMX_XSE_MANAGER             I GET_EDITOR                    Delivers an Editor Instance                                 .
IF_CMX_XSE_MANAGER             I GET_UTILITY                   Provides the Utility Object                                 .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_APPLICATION I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Delivers a Subscreen                                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_DESTINATION I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Delivers a Subscreen                                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_PLUGIN      I GET_PLUGIN                    Delivers a Plug-In                                          .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_RUNTIME     I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Delivers a Subscreen                                        .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_SIMULATION  I GET_PLUGIN                    Provides a Plug-In for Simulation                           .
IF_CMX_XSE_SERVICE_WIZARD      I GET_WIZARD                    Provides a Wizard                                           .
IF_CMX_XSE_SUBSCREEN           I GET_SETTINGS                  Settings Request                                            .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I BROWSE_DESTINATIONS           Displays a Dialog Box for Selection of Destinations         .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I BROWSE_DOMAINS                Displays a Dialog Box for Selection of CMX Domains          .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I BROWSE_PARAMETERS             Displays a Dialog Box for Selection of Parameters for XStep .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I BROWSE_REPOSITORY_ITEMS       Displays a Popup for Selection of Repository Items          .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I BROWSE_SYMBOLS                Displays a Dialog Box for Selection of Valuation Symbols    .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I EDIT_COMPLEX_VALUE            Processes a Complex Value in an Appropriate Editor          .
IF_CMX_XSE_UTILITY             I GET_REPOSITORY_ITEM_INFO      Provides Node Information about a Repository Item           .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I GET_AUTHORITY_GROUP           Authorization Group Output                                  .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I GET_FOLDER_DATA               Delivers Additional Data on an SXS Folder                   .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I GET_LOCATION                  Output Location                                             .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I GET_MTEXT                     Output Descriptive Text                                     .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I SET_AUTHORITY_GROUP           Change authorization group                                  .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I SET_LOCATION                  Change Location                                             .
IF_CMX_XSR_FOLDER_INTERACTIVE  I SET_MTEXT                     Change Descriptive Text                                     .
IF_CMX_XSR_ITEM_INTERACTIVE    I GET_ITEM_DATA                 Delivers Additional Data on an SXS Item                     .
IF_CMX_XSR_ITEM_INTERACTIVE    I GET_LOCATION                  Output Location                                             .
IF_CMX_XSR_ITEM_INTERACTIVE    I GET_MTEXT                     Output Descriptive Text                                     .
IF_CMX_XSR_ITEM_INTERACTIVE    I GET_WHERE_USED_LIST           Delivers List for Where-Used List for Standard XStep        .
IF_CMX_XSR_ITEM_INTERACTIVE    I SET_MTEXT                     Change Descriptive Text                                     .
IF_CMX_XSR_NODE_INTERACTIVE    I GET_STEXT                     Output Short Text                                           .
IF_CMX_XSR_NODE_INTERACTIVE    I SET_STEXT                     Change Short Text                                           .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_INTERACTIVE I GET_VALIDITY_DATE             Output Validity Date                                        .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_INTERACTIVE I GET_VERSION                   Output Version Number                                       .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_INTERACTIVE I GET_VERSION_DATA              Delivers Additional Data on an SXS Version                  .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_INTERACTIVE I SET_VALIDITY_DATE             Change Validity Date                                        .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_INTERACTIVE I SET_VERSION                   Change Version Number                                       .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_STATUS      I ACTION_STATUS_CHECK           Check Status Change                                         .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_STATUS      I GET_STATES                    Output List Status                                          .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_STATUS      I GET_STATUS_OBJECT             Output Status Object (without Authorization Check)          .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_STATUS      I SET_STATUS_OBJECT             Change Status Object (without Authorization Check)          .
IF_CMX_XSR_VERSION_STATUS      I STATUS_CHANGE                 Change status                                               .
IF_CMX_XS_AGENT                I AFTER_SAVE                    After Saving the Objects                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_AGENT                I LOAD                          Loading of Objects                                          .
IF_CMX_XS_AGENT                I PREPARE_LOAD                  Prepare for Loading of Objects                              .
IF_CMX_XS_AGENT                I PREPARE_SAVE                  Prepare for Saving of Objects                               .
IF_CMX_XS_AGENT                I SAVE                          Saving of Objects                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I CHECK_PROPERTY_DOMAIN         Checks a Domain for Usage in the Property Index             .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I DELETE                        Deletes Archived Trees from the Database                    .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I GET_CLOG                      Loads Attributes and Addresses from the Change Logs         .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I GET_CLOG_DOCUMENT             Loads a CLOG for a Handle                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I GET_DOCUMENT                  Loads an XML Document for a URI                             .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I GET_ITEMS                     Loads Tree Attribute from the Archive                       .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I GET_ROOTS                     Loads a Tree from the Archive                               .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I MARK_FOR_ARCHIVE              Selects Persistent Trees for Archiving                      .
IF_CMX_XS_ARCHIVE_MANAGER      I WRITE_TO_ARCHIVE              Writes the Trees Marked for Archiving to the Archive        .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_CONTEXT                    Context Assignment Builder                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_CUSTOM_NODE_BEGIN          SXS Custom Node Builder: Start                              .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_CUSTOM_NODE_END            SXS Custom Node Builder: End                                .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_DESTINATION                Destination Assignment Builder                              .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_GENERATION                 Builder for Generation                                      .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_INSTRUCTION                Process Instruction Builder                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_PARAMETER_EXCHANGE         Builder for Parameter: Exchange                             .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_PARAMETER_INPUT            Builder for Parameter: Input                                .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_PARAMETER_LOCAL            Builder for Parameter: Local                                .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_PARAMETER_OUTPUT           Builder for Parameter: Output                               .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_REFERENCE_BEGIN            Builder for Step Reference: Start                           .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_REFERENCE_END              Builder for Step Reference: End                             .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_ROOT_BEGIN                 Builder for Root: Start                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_ROOT_END                   Builder for Root: End                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_STEP_BEGIN                 Builder for Root: Start                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_STEP_END                   Builder for Step: End                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_XS_DOM_BEGIN               Builder for XS Tree from XS DOM: Start                      .
IF_CMX_XS_BUILDER              I AT_XS_DOM_END                 Builder for XS Tree from XS DOM: End                        .
IF_CMX_XS_CHANGE_OBJECT        I DEREGISTER_PERSISTENT         Deregister Persistent Objects on the API                    .
IF_CMX_XS_CHANGE_OBJECT        I GET_LOADED                    Persistent Roots of the Change Object                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CHANGE_OBJECT        I MAKE_PERSISTENT               Make Transient Objects Persistent                           .
IF_CMX_XS_CHANGE_OBJECT        I MAKE_TRANSIENT                Make Persistent Objects Transient                           .
IF_CMX_XS_CHANGE_OBJECT        I REGISTER_PERSISTENT           Register Persistent Object on the API                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I APPLIES_TO                    Checks Consistancy with Non-Initial Fields in "CONTEXT"     .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_APPLICATION               Provides the Application, that Defines the Context Key      .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_CATEGORY                  Provides the Catagory of the Context Key                    .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_DATA                      Provides the Context Key in the Application Structure       .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_HASH                      Provides a Hash Value for Checking Consistency              .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_REFERENCE                 Provides the Context Key in a Data Reference                .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_RELATED                   Provides Further Context Key, which are Related             .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I GET_STATE                     Provides the Status of the Context Key                      .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I IS_EQUAL                      Checks the Consistency with a Further Context               .
IF_CMX_XS_CONTEXT              I SET_STATE                     Changes the Status of the Context Key                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I CREATE_CHANGE_LOG             Creates an XML Document for the Change Documentation        .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I CUSTOM_NODE_TO_SXS_XML        Creates an SXS XML Document from an SXS (Sub-) Tree         .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I NODE_TO_XML                   Creates an XML Document (XS Schema) from a (Sub-) Tree      .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I PARAMETER_TO_REFERENCE        Creates a Reference from the Parameter Name and Index Value .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I REFERENCE_TO_PARAMETER        Creates Parameter Name and Index Value from a Reference     .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I ROOT_TO_XML_DOM               Creates an XML DOM (Document Object Model) for an XS Root   .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I URI_TO_ROOT                   Creates an XS Tree for an Archive URI                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I XML_ELEMENT_TO_ROOT           Creates an XS Tree from an XML Element                      .
IF_CMX_XS_CONVERTER            I XML_TO_NODE                   Creates a (Sub-) Tree from an XML Document (XS Schema)      .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I APPEND_CHILD                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I CALL_VISITOR                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I DO_COMMAND                    Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I FIND_POSITION                 Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_ANCESTOR                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_CHILDREN                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_COPY                      Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_CUSTOM_TYPE               Provides the Custom Node Type                               .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_DESCRIPTION               Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_DETAILS                   Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_META                      Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I GET_PARENT                    Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I INSERT_CHILD                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I QUERY_INTERFACE               Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I REMOVE_CHILD                  Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_CUSTOM_NODE          I SET_PARENT                    Delivers the Status Object for a Node                       .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION          I GET_NAME                      Provides the Key of the Destination                         .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION          I GET_NEXT_OBJECT               Gets ID of the Destination Object to be Generated Next      .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I CHECK                         Checks the Desination-Specific Semantics of an XStep Tree   .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I DO_COMMAND                    Executes a Command for a Destination Node                   .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I EXECUTE                       Generates Productive Destination Objects for an XStep Tree  .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Provides the Description for a Destination Node             .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I GET_DETAILS                   Provides the Details for a Destination Node                 .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I GET_NEXT_OBJECT               Gets ID of the Destination Object to be Generated Next      .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I GET_OBJECT_STATE              Gets the Status for Generated Destination Objects           .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I GET_ROOT_CTYPES               Gets the Custom Types for Top-Level Custom Nodes            .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I ON_NODE_INSERT                Handles the Supplementation of a Top-Level Custom Node      .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I ON_NODE_REMOVE                Handles the Deletion of a Top-Level Custom Node             .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I ON_ROOT_ASSIGN                Handles the Assignment of an XStep Tree                     .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I ON_ROOT_DELETE                Handles the Deletion of an XStep Tree                       .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I ON_ROOT_UNASSIGN              Handles the Deletion of an Assignment to an XStep Tree      .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I PARSE                         Parses a Characteristic List and Provides (Custom-) Nodes   .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I RENDER                        Renders (custom-)nodes in a Characteristic List             .
IF_CMX_XS_DESTINATION_HANDLER  I TEST                          Generates Destination Objects for Testing an XStep Tree     .
IF_CMX_XS_DIRECTOR             I CALL_BUILDER                  Calls the Builder                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I DEREGISTER_DATA               De-registration of LIVE Data Changes                        .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I DEREGISTER_STATE              De-registration of LIVE Status Changes                      .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I GET_LIVE_DATA                 Read LIVE Data from Parameters                              .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I GET_LIVE_STATE                Read LIVE Status from XSteps                                .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I REGISTER_DATA                 Registration of LIVE Data Changes                           .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I REGISTER_STATE                Registration of LIVE Status Changes                         .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I SET_LIVE_DATA                 Change LIVE Data from Parameters                            .
IF_CMX_XS_EXCHANGE_MANAGER     I SET_LIVE_STATE                Change LIVE Status from XSteps                              .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_AUTO_CORRECTION        Generates a Visitor That Carries Out Automatic Correction   .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_CHANGE_OBJECT_BY_META  Generates a Change Object from Metadata                     .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_CHANGE_OBJECT_CHGNO    Generates a Historical Change Object Using Change Number    .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_CHANGE_OBJECT_DATE     Generates a Historical Change Object Using a Date           .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_CHANGE_OBJECT_NONHIST  Generates a Non-Historical Change Object                    .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_CONVERTER              Generates a Converter                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_1STEP         Generates an Iterator via an XStep                          .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_ALL           Generates an Iterator Above All Nodes                       .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_CLOG          Creates an Iterator Using Nodes for CLOG Generation         .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_DST           Generates a Iterator Above Nodes for an Destination Object  .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_NTYPE         Generates an Iterator Above Nodes for a Particular Node Type.
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_ITERATOR_RTM           Generates an Iterator Using a Runtime Node                  .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_COLLECTION        Generates a Node Collection                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_CONTEXT           Generates a Transient Node: Context                         .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_CONTEXT_BY_META   Generates a Transient Node: Context from Metadata           .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_CUSTOM            Generates a Transient Node: Custom Node                     .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_DESTINATION       Generates a Transient Node: Destination                     .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_GENERATION        Generates a Transient Node: Generation                      .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_GUID              Generates a GUID for Persistent or Transient Nodes          .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_INSTR             Generates a Transient Node: Process Instruction             .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_PARAMETER_EXCHANGEGenerates a Transient Node: Parameter EXCHANGE              .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_PARAMETER_INPUT   Generates a Transient Node: Parameter INPUT                 .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_PARAMETER_LOCAL   Generates a Transient Node: Parameter LOCAL                 .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_PARAMETER_OUTPUT  Generates a Transient Node: Paramter OUPUT                  .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_ROOT              Generates a Transient Node: Root                            .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_SEARCH            Generates an Object for Node Search                         .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_STEP              Generates a Transient Node: Step                            .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_NODE_STEPREF           Generates a Transient Node: Step Reference                  .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_QUERY_GENERATION       Generates a Request Object: Scope of Generation             .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_QUERY_SYMBOL           Generates a Request Object: Valuation Symbol                .
IF_CMX_XS_FACTORY              I CREATE_SEMANTIC_CHECK         Generates an Object for Semantics Check                     .
IF_CMX_XS_GENERATION           I GET_NAME                      Provides the Name of the Scope of Generation                .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I CHECK_CONTENT                 Checks a Characteristic List                                .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I GET_CATEGORY                  Gets the Instruction Type                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I GET_CONTENT                   Gets the Contents                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I GET_PARSE_RESULT              Returns the Results of Parsing a Process Instruction        .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I GET_STEXT                     Gets the Description                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I GET_TYPE                      Delivers the Instruction Type                               .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I SET_CATEGORY                  Sets the Instruction Type                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I SET_CONTENT                   Sets the Contents                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I SET_STEXT                     Sets the Description                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_INSTRUCTION          I SET_TYPE                      Sets the Type                                               .
IF_CMX_XS_ITERATOR             I RUN                           Start Visit of Nodes                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I CHECK_CLOG_TABNAME            Checks the Table Type for Change Documents                  .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I CHECK_CONTEXT_TABNAME         Checks Context Table Type                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I CHECK_REPOSITORY_NAME         Checks Repository Name                                      .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I DELETE_CLOG_BY_NID            Deletes All Change Logs for a NID                           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I DELETE_ROOT_BY_NID            Deletes Entire Tree and All Change Logs for a NID           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I DELETE_TREE_BY_NID            Deletes Entire Tree for a NID                               .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I FREE_ROOT                     Removes a Loaded Tree                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I FREE_ROOTS                    Removes all Loaded Trees                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_ACTION_BADIS              Provides Application with BAdI Status for Operation Control .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_ACTION_LIST               Provides Business Operations for XSteps                     .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_APPLICATION_LIST          Provides Registered Applications                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CHANGES_BY_NID            Provides the Versions for a Tree                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CLOG_DOCUMENT             Provides the XML Document for a Change Log Entry            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CLOG_LIST                 Provides Change Log Entries                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CLOG_TABNAME              Provides the Name of a Table for Change Documents           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CONTEXT_BADIS             Provides Application with BAdI Status for Context Request   .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CONTEXT_BY_NIDS           Provides Application-Specific Context Data for NIDs         .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CONTEXT_TABNAME           Gets the Name of a Context Table                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CUSTOM_CATEGORY_LIST      Gets the Available Catagories for Custom Types              .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_CUSTOM_TYPE_LIST          Gets the Custom Types Available                             .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DATA_CATEGORY_LIST        Gets Catagories for Valuation Symbols and Generations       .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DESTINATION_BADIS         Gets Available Destination Types with BAdI Status           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DESTINATION_LIST          Gets Available Destinations                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DESTINATION_LOCATIONS     Gets Available Locations with Defined Destinations          .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DESTINATION_SETTINGS      Gets the Settings for the Destination Type                  .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_DESTINATION_TYPES         Gets Available Destination Types                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_GENERATION_BADIS          Gets Available Scopes of Generation with BAdI Status        .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_GENERATION_LIST           Gets Available Scopes of Generation                         .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_NAMESPACE_LIST            Gets Released Namespaces                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_NIDS_BY_CONTEXT           Gets the Root Keys for a Context                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_REPOSITORY_BADIS          Gets Available XS-Repositories with BAdI                    .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_REPOSITORY_LIST           Gets Available XS-Repositories                              .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_REPOSITORY_OBJECT         Gets a Specific Repository Object                           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_ROOT_BY_CONTEXT           Loads XStep Tree for Context-Specified                      .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_ROOT_BY_NID               Loads XStep Tree for Root Key                               .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_SYMBOL_BADIS              Gets Available Valuation Symbols with BAdI Status           .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_SYMBOL_LIST               Gets Available Valuation Symbols                            .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_SYMBOL_TEXT               Gets the Description for the Valuation Symbol               .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I GET_VARIANT_LIST              Gets Registered BAdI Variants for Applications              .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I MARK_FOR_ARCHIVE              Selects Persistent Trees for Archiving                      .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I REFRESH_SETUP_BUFFER          Reloads Data in Buffer for Basic Settings                   .
IF_CMX_XS_LIBRARY              I SORT_ROOTS                    Standard Sort Order for XStep Trees                         .
IF_CMX_XS_META                 I GET_LIST                      Provides a List of Known Metadata                           .
IF_CMX_XS_META                 I GET_META                      Provides the Value for a Meta Date                          .
IF_CMX_XS_META                 I SET_META                      Sets the Value for a Meta Date                              .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I APPEND_CHILD                  Adds a Subordinated Node                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I CALL_VISITOR                  Calls a Visitor with the Correct Method                     .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I DO_COMMAND                    Executes a Node-Specifie Command                            .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I FIND_POSITION                 Finds a Suitable Insertion Position                         .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_ANCESTOR                  Provides the Next Node in the Hierarchy for the Interface   .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_CHILDREN                  Provides a List of Subordinated Nodes                       .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_COPY                      Provides a Copy of the Node Subtree                         .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_DESCRIPTION               Provides a Description of the Node                          .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_DETAILS                   Provides Details for the Node                               .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I GET_PARENT                    Returns the Superordinated Nodes                            .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I INSERT_CHILD                  Adds a Subordinated Node                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I REMOVE_CHILD                  Removes a Subordinated Node                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE                 I SET_PARENT                    Changes the Assignment of the Superordinated Node           .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_COLLECTION      I GET_NODES                     Gets the Contained Nodes                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_CONSTRAINT      I ON_CHANGE                     Recall Before Changing a Node in a Tree                     .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_CONSTRAINT      I ON_INSERT                     Recall Before Adding a Node to a Tree                       .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_CONSTRAINT      I ON_REMOVE                     Recall Before Deleting a Node from a Tree                   .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_SEARCH          I GET_RANGE                     Returns the Search Criteria as Range on the Initiator       .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_SEARCH          I SEARCH                        Node Search Using the XS Tree                               .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_SEARCH          I SEARCH_IN_RESULT              Searches Using the Result Nodes of Other Operations (Check) .
IF_CMX_XS_NODE_SEARCH          I SET_RANGE                     Specifies the Search Criteria as a Range on Search Object   .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_DOMAIN                    Gets the Domains                                            .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_MODE                      Gets the Valuation Mode                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_NAME                      Gets the Name                                               .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_REFERENCE                 Gets the Name of the Referenced Parameter                   .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_STEXT                     Gets the Description                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_SYMBOL                    Gets the Assigned Valuation Symbol                          .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_TYPE                      Gets the Type                                               .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I GET_VALUE                     Gets the Current Value                                      .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I IS_LIVE                       Returns whether the Live Flag is set on the Parameter       .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I IS_TABLE                      Returns whether the Parameter is a Table Parameter          .
IF_CMX_XS_PARAMETER            I SET_VALUE                     Sets a Parameter Value Again                                .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I GET_CHANGE_INFO               Administration Data                                         .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I GET_CHANGE_OBJECT             Returns the Change Object                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I IS_VALID                      Check whether the Node is Valid                             .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I LOAD                          Loads the Complete Subtree                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I NOTIFY_CHANGED                Confirm Change to a Child Node                              .
IF_CMX_XS_PERSISTENT           I NOTIFY_CHANGING               Register a Change to a Child                                .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I ADD_QUERY                     Adds the Data from Another Scope of Generation              .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I DELETE                        Deletes Single or All Repeats                               .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I GET_CONTEXT                   Provides the Context for the Copy Template or for Repeat    .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I GET_COUNT                     Provides the Set Number of Repeats                          .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I GET_STEP                      Provides the Copy Template (for the Repeated XStep)         .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I GET_SYMBOLS                   Provides the Symbol Request Object for the Particular Repeat.
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I REFRESH                       Resets the Request Object for an Renewed Data Query         .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets the Context for a Single Repeat                        .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_GENERATION     I SET_COUNT                     Sets the Number of Repeats Required                         .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_CONTEXT                   Gets the Assigned Context Key of the Application            .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_FIXED                     Gets Defined Fixed Valuations                               .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_STEP                      Gets the Assigned XStep,for Which the Request is Running    .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE                     Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Domain Value               .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_DATE           Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Date                       .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_FLOAT          Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Floating Point Number      .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_INTEGER        Gets the Value for a Symbol as an Integer                   .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_NUMC           Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Numerical Char. String     .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_PACKED         Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Packed Number              .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_STRING         Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Character String           .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_STRUCTURE      Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Structure                  .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_TABLE          Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Table                      .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_TIME           Gets the Value for a Symbol as a Time                       .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I GET_VALUE_INTO_XSTRING        Gets the Value for a Symbol as Byte Sequence                .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I IS_VALUATED                   Has the Symbol Already been Valuated                        .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I REFRESH                       Returns the Request Object                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_STEP                      Subsequently Sets the Assigned XStep (no change!)           .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE                     Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Domain Value     .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_DATE           Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Date             .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_FLOAT          Sets the Value for the Request Sym. from Floating Point No. .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_INTEGER        Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Integer          .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_NUMC           Sets the Value for the Req. Sym. from Numerical Char. String.
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_PACKED         Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Packed Number    .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_STRING         Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Character String .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_STRUCTURE      Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Structure        .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_TABLE          Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Table            .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_TEXT           Sets the Value for Request Symbol from SAP Script Text      .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_TIME           Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Time             .
IF_CMX_XS_QUERY_SYMBOL         I SET_VALUE_FROM_XSTRING        Sets the Value for the Request Symbol from Byte String      .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY           I GET_ITEM                      Provides an Item Object for Item GUID                       .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY           I GET_NAME                      Provides the Name of the Repository                         .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY           I GET_NODE                      Provides a Custom Node for Visualization of the Repository  .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY_ITEM      I CONTAINS_ITEM                 Checks Whether the Transferred Item is Contained            .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY_ITEM      I GET_COPY                      Provides a Copy of the XS Tree                              .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY_ITEM      I GET_NODE                      Provides a Custom Node for Visualizing the Item             .
IF_CMX_XS_REPOSITORY_ITEM      I GET_PARAMETERS                Provides a Description of the Item Interface                .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I CLOG_ACTIVATE                 Activate Change Log                                         .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I CLOG_ACTIVATED                Specifies Whether the Change Log is Active                  .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I CLOSE_REFERENCE               Closes all References in the Tree                           .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I COPY_TO_STEP                  Gets a Copy as Step                                         .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I CREATE_VERSION                Generate Version of a Tree                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I DELETE                        Deletion of a Tree                                          .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I EDIT                          Switch Tree to Change Mode                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I EXECUTE                       Create Control Recipe                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GENERATE                      Generate Tree                                               .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GENERATE_UNDO                 Reset Generation in Tree                                    .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_ARCHIVE_STATE             Returns the Archiving Status                                .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_CONTEXT_LIST              Returns the Contexts from the Tree                          .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_GENERATION_STATE          Gets the Status of the Generation of the Tree               .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_META_OBJECT               Gets the Associated Metadata Object of the Application      .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_ORIGINAL                  Returns the ID for the Copy Template (not persistent)       .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Gets the Original Timestamp of the Tree                     .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I IS_CHANGED                    Returns whether the Tree has been Changed                   .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I IS_CREATED                    Returns, whether the Tree has been newly created            .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I IS_DELETED                    Returns Whether the Tree was Deleted                        .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I LOCK                          Locks a Tree to Prevent Changes                             .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I OPEN_REFERENCE                Explode all References in the Tree                          .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I REFRESH                       Refreshes a Tree to Display the Last Current Status         .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I SET_APPLICATION               Sets the Application to New and Changes the Contexts if Req..
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I SHOW                          Switches the Tree into Display Mode                         .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I SIMULATE                      Returns a Transient, Simulated Tree                         .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I TEST                          Generated a Test Control Recipe                             .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I UNDO                          Undo Function for all Changes Made to a Tree                .
IF_CMX_XS_ROOT                 I UNLOCK                        Unlocks a Locked Tree                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_SEMANTIC_CHECK       I CHECK                         Check of the XS Tree                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_SEMANTIC_CHECK       I CHECK_IN_RESULT               Check of the Result Nodes from other Operations (e.g.search).
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I GET_NODE_CONSTRAINT           Provides the Node-Constraint-Object for the Application     .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ACTION_CANCEL              Recall After Canceling a Confirmed Operation                .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ACTION_COMPLETE            Recall After Successful Execution of an Operation           .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ACTION_EXECUTE             Recall for Execution of an Application-Specifiy Operation   .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ACTION_PREPARE             Recall for Confirmation of an Operation with Status Change  .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ACTION_SELECT              Recall for Selection of Executable Operations               .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_ARCHIVE_SELECT             Recall for Confirmation of "to be Archived" Indicators      .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_ACTION       I ON_EXECUTION_COMPLETED        Recall on Completionl of the Last Productive Object         .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I GET_DESCRIPTION               Provides the Node Description for the Context Key           .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I GET_DETAILS                   Provides the Node Details for the Context Key               .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I GET_META_OBJECT               Provides a META Object of the Application for a Tree        .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I GET_RELATED                   Provides Further Context Key, which are Related             .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I GET_STATE                     Delivers the Status for the Context Key                     .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_CONTEXT      I SET_STATE                     Changes the Status for the Context Key                      .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_HANDLER                   Provides a Handler Instance for Destination                 .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_LIST                      Provides a List of Destinations                             .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_LOCATIONS                 Provides a List of Locations that Define the Destinations   .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_NODE                      Provides an Instance of the Custom-Node-Type                .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_SETTINGS                  Gets the Settings for the Destination Type                  .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_DST          I GET_STATE                     Provides the Execution Status for Root GUID                 .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_GENERATION   I GET_DATA                      Provides the Data for the Scope of Generation               .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_REPOSITORY   I GET_REPOSITORY                Provides an Instance for Name                               .
IF_CMX_XS_SERVICE_SYMBOL       I GET_DATA                      Provides the Date for the Symbols                           .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks the Authorization of Current User                    .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I CHECK_EXECUTION_STATE         Checks the Execution Status of the Root GUID                .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I DEQUEUE_PERSISTENT            Deletes a Lock for a Persistent Node                        .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I DEQUEUE_REPOSITORY            Deletes a Lock for a Repository                             .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I ENQUEUE_PERSISTENT            Sets a Lock for a Persisten Node                            .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I ENQUEUE_REPOSITORY            Sets a Lock for a Repository                                .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I GET_APPLICATION_VARIANT       Provides the Current BAdI Varient for an Application        .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I GET_CHECK_PROFILE             Returns the Check Level                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I IS_CHANGED                    Persistent objects have been changed                        .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I IS_COMPLETED                  Gets, Whether the Specified Trees have been Completed       .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I SAVE                          Saves all Changes                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I SET_APPLICATION_VARIANT       Explicitly Sets the BAdI Variant for an Application         .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I SET_CHECK_PROFILE             Sets the Check Level                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I UNDO                          Undo Function for all Changes                               .
IF_CMX_XS_SESSION              I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Updates Context Nodes after Change of Application Data      .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I CHECK                         Check Semantics                                             .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I COPY_TO_ROOT                  Converts a Step in a Root                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GENERATION_EXECUTED           Returns whether the Generation has Already been Executed    .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_APPLICATION               Gets the Direct or Indirect Assigned Applications           .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_CONTEXT                   Gets the Direct or Indirect Assigned Context                .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_CONTEXT_LIST              Returns the Context from the Subtree                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_DESTINATION               Gets the Direct or Indirect Assigned Destinations           .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_DESTINATION_LIST          Gets the Destination of the Subtrees                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_GENERATION                Gets the Directly or Indirectly Assigned Scopes of Gen.     .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_LIVE_STATE                Returns the Live Status                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_PARAMETERS                Gets the Assigned Parameters                                .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_PREDECESSORS              Outputs the Directly or Indirectly Assigned Predecessors    .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_PREDECESSOR_MODE          Outputs the Determination Type for the Predecessors         .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_STATE                     Gets the Processing Status                                  .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_STEXT                     Gets the Description                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_SUCCESSORS                Outputs the Successor                                       .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_SYMBOLS                   Gets an Assigned Request Object for Symbol Valuation        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I GET_TEMPLATE                  Returns the ID of the Templates                             .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets the Assigned Context                                   .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_DESTINATION               Sets the Directly Assigned Destinations                     .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_GENERATION                Sets the Directyl Assigned Scope of Generation              .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_LIVE_STATE                Sets the Live Status                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_PARAMETER                 Changes a Parameter or Adds it Again                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_PREDECESSORS              Newly Sets the Direct Predecessors                          .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_PREDECESSOR_MODE          Newly Sets the Art of Determination of the Predecessor      .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP                 I SET_STEXT                     Sets the Description                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I CLOSE                         Close Reference                                             .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I COPY_INTERFACE                Adopt Interface of SXS                                      .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I EXISTS                        Checks whether the Reference Exists                         .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I GET_ITEM                      Returns the Repository Item                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I IS_OPEN                       Returns Whether the Reference has been Exploded             .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I OPEN                          Explode Reference                                           .
IF_CMX_XS_STEP_REFERENCE       I SET_ITEM                      Sets the Repository Item Again                              .
IF_CMX_XS_UNKNOWN              I QUERY_INTERFACE               Query Special Interface                                     .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_CONTEXT                 Visitor Method: Context Key                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_CUSTOM                  Visitor Method: Custom Node                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_DESTINATION             Visitor Method: Destination                                 .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_GENERATION              Visitor Method: Scope of Generation (Repeat)                .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_INSTRUCTION             Visitor Method: Process Instruction                         .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_PARAMETER_EXCHANGE      Visitor Method: Parameter with Type EXCHANGE                .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_PARAMETER_INPUT         Visitor Method: Parameter with Type INPUT                   .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_PARAMETER_LOCAL         Visitor Method: Parameter with Type Local                   .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_PARAMETER_OUTPUT        Visitor Method: Parameter with Type OUTPUT                  .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_REFERENCE               Visitor Method: XStep Reference                             .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_ROOT                    Visitor Method: Root                                        .
IF_CMX_XS_VISITOR              I VISIT_STEP                    Visitor Method: XStep                                       .
IF_CM_API                      I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization in CM Environment                             .
IF_CM_API                      I CMO_BROWSE_STRUCTURE          Display the Structure of the CM Object in a Control         .
IF_CM_API                      I CMO_CHANGE                    Given CM Object Is Loaded Changed                           .
IF_CM_API                      I CMO_LOAD                      CM Object with Given Key Is Loaded                          .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_CHANGE         Given Baseline Can Now Be Changed                           .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_CREATE         Create a configuration Baseline                             .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_DELETE         Given Baseline Should Be Deleted                            .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_EXPLODE        Automatic Explosion Mechanism Running                       .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_FREEZE         Freeze the Baseline                                         .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_GETDETAIL      For Mass Reading of Baseline Data                           .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGBASELINE_GETLIST        Gives Table with Baseline Key to Selection Criteria         .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_CHANGE       Given Definition Can Now Be Changed                         .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_CREATE       Create a Configuration Definition                           .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_DELETE       Given Definition Should Be Deleted                          .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_GETDETAIL    For Mass Reading of Definition Data                         .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_GETLCNET     Returns Folder and Baseline Network to a Config. Definition .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGDEFINITION_GETLIST      Gives Table with Definition Key to Selection Criteria       .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_CHANGE           Given Folder Can Now Be Changed                             .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_CREATE           Creation of a Configuration Folder                          .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_DELETE           Given Folder Should Be Deleted                              .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_GETDETAIL        For Mass Reading of Folder Data                             .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_GETLIST          Gives Table with Folder Key to Selection Criteria           .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_GETPREDECESSORS  Return the Predecessor Folder                               .
IF_CM_API                      I CONFIGFOLDER_GETSUCCESSORS    Return the Successor Folder                                 .
IF_CM_API                      I EXISTENCE_CHECK               Checks the Existence of a CM Object for Given Key           .
IF_CM_API                      I IS_CHANGE_ALLOWED             Structure Object Can (Not) Be Changed                       .
IF_CM_API                      I IS_USED                       Where-Used List: Is Object in a Folder/Baseline?            .
IF_CM_API                      I MODIFY_WORKLIST               Changed Entries for Worklist                                .
IF_CM_API                      I SAVE                          All Changes Are Saved                                       .
IF_CM_API                      I SET_STATUS                    Changes the Status of the CM Object                         .
IF_CM_API                      I START_CM_ENVIRONMENT          CM Environment Started                                      .
IF_CM_API                      I STOP_CM_ENVIRONMENT           CM Environment Exited                                       .
IF_CM_API                      I SWITCH_SEMKEY_AND_GUID        Switches Semantic Key and GUID                              .
IF_CM_API                      I UNDO                          All Changes Are Discarded                                   .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I BASELINE                      Fixed ERP Object                                            .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I GET_CHANGE_NUMBER_OBJECT      Returns Object Which Has All Change Numbers                 .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I GET_DEPENDENT                 Delivers All Subordinate ERP Objects (n Levels!)            .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I GET_EXT_FOX_DATA              Returns Data in External FOX Format                         .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I GET_FOX_DATA                  Returns Data for Conversion in FOX Format                   .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I INIT                          Determining Selection Quantity for Baseline-Relevant Data   .
IF_CM_BASELINE                 I REFRESH                       Deleting Baselining-Relevant Buffer                         .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I GET_ACTIVITY                  Return the activity                                         .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I GET_CLASS_AGENT               Manages individual objects of class                         .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I GET_CONTROLLER                Sets the private Attribute Controller                       .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I INTERPRETE                    Interpretes the activity                                    .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I REFRSH_DATA                   Refresh the data                                            .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I SET_ACTIVITY                  Which activity does the user want to execute?               .
IF_CM_CARRIER                  I SET_COMMAND                   Sets the current function code                              .
IF_CM_DATA                     I GET_DATA                      Gets data from the object that the IF implements            .
IF_CM_DATA                     I SET_DATA                      Transports data into the object that the IF implements      .
IF_CM_DATA_REGISTER            I DEREGISTER                    Deregistering ALL registrations                             .
IF_CM_DATA_REGISTER            I REGISTER                      Registering for reading/writing of data, 1x per transaction .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I CHANGE_STATUS                 Change system status and check whether transition is allowed.
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_BOR_KEY                   Delivers the BOR key for the object                         .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_COMPLETE_STRUCTURE        BCM-"External: Gets structure table                         .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_DYNP_DATA                 BCM -" Screen: Gets content and display attributes          .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_LOG_HANDLE                Reads handle for application log                            .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_SEM_KEY                   Delivers semantic key of the object                         .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_STRUC_ADMIN_INFO          BCM -" Screen: Gets admin. info about structure             .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I GET_TEXT                      BCM -" Screen: Gets text table                              .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I HAS_CHANGED                   Delivers CMT_CO_TRUE if object has been changed             .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I INIT_EXT_COMP                 Initializes a related external component                    .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I IS_SAVED_BEFORE               Is the object in the database?                              .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I READ_STATUS                   Reads all system statuses                                   .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I SET_COMPLETE_STRUCTURE        External-"BCM: Sets structure table                         .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I SET_DYNP_DATA                 Screen -" BCM: Sets content of an attribute                 .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I SET_STRUC_ADMIN_INFO          Screen -" BCM: Sets admin. info for structure               .
IF_CM_OBJECT                   I SET_TEXT                      Screen -" BCM: Sets text table                              .
IF_CM_OBSERVER                 I UPDATE_SELF                   Update own data using the CM                                .
IF_CM_OBSERVER                 I UPDATE_SUBJECTS               Update instances with data from outside                     .
IF_CM_READ                     I GET_CONTROLLER                Sets the private Attribute Controller                       .
IF_CM_READ                     I REFRESH_DATA                  Refresh the data                                            .
IF_COA_CALCULATION_METHOD      I CALCULATE                     Performs Calculation                                        .
IF_COA_CO_TOTALS_CONVERTER     I READ_TRANS_DATA               Reads Transaction Data from DB into CO_TOTALS               .
IF_COA_CO_TOTALS_CONVERTER     I UPDATE_TRANS_DATA             Writes Changes from CO_TOTALS into DB                       .
IF_COINT_ERR_CP                I GIVE_MARKED_OBJECTS           Delivers the Selected Objects                               .
IF_COIS_DISP_TREE              I FREE                          Release ALV Tree                                            .
IF_COIS_DISP_TREE              I SET_INITIAL_DATA              Copy Tables                                                 .
IF_COIS_DISP_TREE              I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Generate ALV Tree in Container                              .
IF_COLUMN_TREE_MODEL_ITEM_PROV I LOAD_ITEMS                    Load Items on Demand                                        .
IF_COL_ACTION                  I EXECUTE                       Ausführen Aktion                                            .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I DELETE                        Löschen                                                     .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I INSERT                        Einfügen                                                    .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I SELECT                        Lesen                                                       .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I SELECT_BY_RELATION            Lesen über Relationen                                       .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I UPDATE                        Update                                                      .
IF_COL_ASPECT                  I UPDATE_FIELDS                 deprecated - do not implement                               .
IF_COL_QUERY                   I EXECUTE                       Query                                                       .
IF_COL_REPOSITORY_ACCESSOR     I GET_SERVICE_MODULE_DATA       Read Data of a Service Module                               .
IF_COL_REPOSITORY_ACCESSOR     I GET_SERVICE_MODULE_NAMES      Read All Available Service Modules                          .
IF_COL_REPOSITORY_ACCESSOR     I GET_SVC_MOD_CONFIG_NAMES      Read Available Configurations of Service Module             .
IF_COMMAND_MM                  I EXECUTE                       Processing of a Function Code                               .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I CHECK_VALUES_MASTERDATA       Check Master Data                                           .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_PRODUCT_ATTRIBUTE         Read Attribute from Product                                 .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_SERVICE                   Get Reference to Service                                    .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_SERVICES                  Reference to Services Condition Verifier and Calculator     .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_VALUES_BILLING            Read Billing Information                                    .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_VALUES_CONDITIONS         Read Conditions                                             .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_VALUES_DISPLAY            Get Structure Data with Display Values Only                 .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_VALUES_MASTERDATA         Read Master Data                                            .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I GET_VALUES_PARTNERDATA        Read Partner Data                                           .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I REGISTER_SERVICE              Register Service                                            .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I SET_VALUES_CONDITIONS         Write Conditions                                            .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I SET_VALUES_MASTERDATA         Write Master Data                                           .
IF_COMPONENT_MASTERDATA        I SET_VALUES_PARTNERDATA        Write Partner Data                                          .
IF_COMP_PLUGIN                 I ADD_AND_REMOVE_BUTTONS        Add and Remove Buttons                                      .
IF_COMP_PLUGIN                 I GET_GUI_STATUS                GUI Status                                                  .
IF_COMP_PLUGIN                 I GET_MAIN_SCREEN_NR            Screen Number                                               .
IF_COMP_PLUGIN                 I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I CHECK_ACTION_AFTER            Check After Executing Operation, (Re)Set Status             .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I CHECK_ACTION_BEFORE           Check Before Executing Operation, (Re-)Set Status           .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I CHECK_PROFILE_CHANGEABLE      Check Whether Status Profile May Be Changed                 .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I CHECK_STATUS_CHANGEABLE       Check Whether Operation/Status May Be Selected              .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I EXECUTE_ACTION                Execute Operation, (Re)Set Status                           .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I GET_ACTIVITY_VALUES           List of All Allowed Operations                              .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I GET_OBJECT_INFO               Information on Focus Object                                 .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I GET_PROFILE_VALUES            List of All Allowed Status Profiles                         .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I GET_SYSTEM_STATUS_VALUES      List of All System Statuses To Be Set/Deleted               .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I GET_USER_STATUS_VALUES        List of All User Statuses To Be Set/Deleted                 .
IF_COM_BSP_STATUS              I SET_PROFILE                   Set Status Profile                                          .
IF_COM_BSP_WORKFLOW            I GET_OBJECT_KEY                Determination of the Object Key for the CRM UI Key          .
IF_COM_COS                     I CHANGE                        Change Estimated-Costs Data                                 .
IF_COM_COS                     I DELETE                        Delete Estimated Costs                                      .
IF_COM_COS                     I INIT                          Initialize Buffer                                           .
IF_COM_COS                     I PROVIDE                       Get Estimated-Costs Data                                    .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I CHECK_DATA                    Checks Buffer                                               .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I FREE_BUFFER                   Deletes Buffers                                             .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I GET_CHANGES                   Determines Changed Data                                     .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets Instance                                               .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I LOCK                          Blocks Table                                                .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I MAINTAIN_UPDATE               Receives Changed Data                                       .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I READ_ALL                      Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I READ_ALL_M                    Reads All Entries from Maintenance Buffer                   .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I READ_SINGLE                   Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I READ_SINGLE_M                 Reads an Entry from the Maintenance Buffer                  .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I SAVE                          Saves the Changed Data                                      .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I UNLOCK                        Unlocks Table                                               .
IF_COM_DIFF_KEY_TYPE_REP       I UPDATE_CHK_BUFFER             Fills Checked Buffer from Maintenance Buffer                .
IF_COM_EEW_APD_MD              I ADD_PROGRAM_INFO              Callback: Enrich Infos for Program Generation               .
IF_COM_EEW_APD_MD              I GET_EXTENSION_DETAILS         Callback: Details for Extension                             .
IF_COM_EEW_APD_MD              I GET_FIELDINFO                 Callback: Simulates Function Module DDIF_FIELDINFO_GET      .
IF_COM_EEW_APD_MD              I GET_TEXTTABLE                 Callback: Find Text Table for Check Table                   .
IF_COM_EEW_APD_MD              I GET_TEXTTABLE_FIELDINFO       Callback: Simulates FB DDIF_FIELDINFO_GET for Text Table    .
IF_COM_IL_KEYTYPE_ID           I FIELDNAME_BY_KEYTYPE_GET      Relationships: Determine Field Names Using Key Type ID      .
IF_COM_IL_KEYTYPE_ID           I KEYTYPE_ID_GET                Relationships: Reading Key Type IDs for an Object Type      .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I CHECK_DATA                    Checks Buffer                                               .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I FREE_BUFFER                   Deletes Buffers                                             .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I GET_CHANGES                   Determines Changed Data                                     .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets Instance                                               .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I LOCK                          Blocks Table                                                .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I MAINTAIN_UPDATE               Receives Changed Data                                       .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I READ_ALL                      Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I READ_ALL_M                    Reads All Entries from Maintenance Buffer                   .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I READ_SINGLE                   Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I READ_SINGLE_M                 Reads an Entry from the Maintenance Buffer                  .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I SAVE                          Saves the Changed Data                                      .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I UNLOCK                        Unlocks Table                                               .
IF_COM_LH_OBJ_KEY_TYPE_REP     I UPDATE_CHK_BUFFER             Fills Checked Buffer from Maintenance Buffer                .
IF_COM_LTX                     I TEXT_CHANGE                   Change a Text for an Object State                           .
IF_COM_LTX                     I TEXT_CREATE                   Create a New Long Text for an Object State                  .
IF_COM_LTX                     I TEXT_DELETE                   Delete a Text for a State                                   .
IF_COM_LTX                     I TEXT_PROVIDE                  Outputs the Text for an Object                              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Collection                                           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I GET_ALL                       Access Method for Objects (Read)                            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I GET_NUMBER                    Access Method for Number of Contained Objects (Read)        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I GET_OWNER                     Access Method for Collection Owner (Read)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION       I HAS_ENTRIES                   Does the Collection Contain Objects?                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION_ITEM  I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COLLECTION_ITEM  I GET_COLLECTION                Access Method for Collection (Read)                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I CHECK                         Check Consistency of Object                                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I DELETE                        Delete Object                                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I GET_STATE                     Access Method for Technical Object State (Read)             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I HAS_CHANGES                   Have Changes Been Made to the Object?                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I IS_DELETED                    Has Object Been Deleted?                                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is Object Already Persistent?                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I IS_VALID                      Is Object Valid?                                            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_COMMON           I NOTIFY_CHANGES_COMMITED       Changes to Object Have Been Saved (Internal Use)            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I ADD_REFERRING_LINK            Add Reference to Link                                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Key Category                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_ATTRIBUTES_EXT            Access Method for Key Attributes (External Format)          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_ATTRIBUTES_EXT_REF        Access Method for Key Attributes Data Object (External)     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_ATTRIBUTES_INT            Access Method for Key Attributes (Internal Format)          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_ATTRIBUTES_INT_REF        Access Method for Key Attributes Data Object (Internal)     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_DATA                      Access Method for Key(s) (Internal Format)                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_DATA_REF                  Access Method for Key Data Object (Internal Format)         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_DEFINITION_EXT            Access Method for Key Definition (External Format)          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_DEFINITION_INT            Access Method for Key Definition (Internal Format)          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_DESCRIPTION               Access Method to Short Text/Description (Read)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_GUID                      Access Method for GUID (Read)                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_TYPE                      Access Method for Key Category                              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I GET_USAGE                     Access Method to Key Usage                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY              I REMOVE_REFERRING_LINK         Delete Reference to Link                                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_ALL                       Access Method for All Keys (Reading)                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_BY_ATTRIBUTES_EXT         Access Method for Key(s) with Attributes (External Format)  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_BY_ATTRIBUTES_INT         Access Method for Key(s) with Attributes (Internal Format)  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_BY_GUID                   Access Method for Key(s) with GUID (Reading)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_BY_TYPE                   Access Method for Key(s) with Key Category (Reading)        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEYS             I GET_BY_TYPE_AND_USAGE         Access Method to Key with Key Type and Usage                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I CHECK                         Check Key Component                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I CONVERT_EXT_2_INT             Conversion from External to Internal Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I CONVERT_INT_2_EXT             Conversion from Internal to External Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Proxy Object                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I GET_DESCRIPTION               Access Method for Text (Read)                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPNT_PROXY I GET_VALUES                    Access Method for Values (Read)                             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENT    I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Key Component                                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENT    I GET_LABELS                    Access Method for Interface Texts (Read)                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENT    I GET_VALUES                    Access Method for Values (Read)                             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENT    I IS_VALID                      Is Value Allowed?                                           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENTS   I CREATE_BY_ROLLNAME            Instantiate Key Component (with Data Element)               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENTS   I GET_ALL                       Access Method for All Key Components (Read)                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_COMPONENTS   I GET_BY_ROLLNAME               Access Method for Key Component with Data Element           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_FACTORY      I BUILD_KEY                     Create Key(s) (with Data in Internal Format)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_FACTORY      I CREATE_KEY                    Create Key(s) (with Data in Internal Format)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_FACTORY      I CREATE_KEY_BY_ATTRIBUTES      Create Key(s) (with Attributes in Internal Format + GUID)   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_FACTORY      I GET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Read)                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_FACTORY      I SET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Write)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I GENERATE_KEY                  Generate Key                                                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I GET_GENERATED_KEY             Access Method for Generated Key (Reading)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I GET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Read)                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I RESET_LOCK                    Access Method for Lock (Delete)                             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I SET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Write)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_GENERATOR    I SET_LOCK                      Access Method for Lock (Write)                              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I GET_KEYS                      Access Method for Collection of Diffentiation Key(s)        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I GET_KEYS_FOR_PRODUCT          Access Method to Keys for Product (Read)                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I GET_KEY_FACTORY               Access Method for Factory of Differentiation Key(s)         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I GET_KEY_GENERATOR             Access Method for Generator of Differentiation Keys         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I GET_KEY_PERSISTENCY           Access Method for Persistence of Differentiation Keys       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I PROVIDE_KEYS_BY_ATTRIBUTES    Retrieve Key(s) (Identified By Attributes)                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I PROVIDE_KEYS_BY_GUID          Retrieve Key(s) (Identified By GUIDS)                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I PROVIDE_KEY_BY_ATTRIBUTES     Retrieve Key(s) (Identified By Attributes)                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I PROVIDE_KEY_BY_GUID           Retrieve Key(s) (Identified By GUID)                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_MANAGER      I TRANSFORM_KEY_ATTRIBUTES_TABLEKey Attributes (Internal) Convert Table Format to Line Form..
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_PERSISTENCY  I GET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Read)                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_PERSISTENCY  I LOAD_KEYS_BY_ATTRIBUTES       Load Key(s) from Database (Identified By Attributes)        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_PERSISTENCY  I LOAD_KEYS_BY_GUID             Load Key(s) from Database (Identified By GUID)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_PERSISTENCY  I READ_KEY_GUIDS_BY_ATTRIBUTES  Read Key(s) from the Database (Identified By Attributes)    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_PERSISTENCY  I SET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Management of Keys (Write)                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CHECK_KEY_ATTRIBUTES          Check Key Attributes                                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CONVERT_KEYS_ATTRIBS_EXT_2_INTConvert Attributes of Several Keys from Ext. to Int. Format .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CONVERT_KEYS_ATTRIBS_INT_2_EXTConvert Attributes of Several Keys from Int. to Ext. Format .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CONVERT_KEY_ATTRIBS_EXT_2_INT Convert Key Attributes from External to Internal Format     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CONVERT_KEY_ATTRIBS_EXT_RANGE Convert Key Attribute Range from External to Internal Format.
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CONVERT_KEY_ATTRIBS_INT_2_EXT Convert Key Attributes from Internal to External Format     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Key Category                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Access Method for Description                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_KEY_DEFINITIONS           Access Method for Key Definitions                           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_KEY_DEFINITIONS_COMPONENTSAccess Method for Components of Key Definitions             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_KEY_TABLE                 Access Method for Table Used to Store Keys                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_KEY_TABLE_COMPONENTS      Access Method for Components of Key Table                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE         I GET_KEY_TABLE_DEFINITIONS     Access Method for Definitions for Storage of Keys           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPES        I GET_ALL                       Method of Access for All Key Categories (Read)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPES        I GET_BY_KEY_TYPE               Method of Access for Key Category with Key Type (Read)      .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I CHECK                         Check Key Component                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I CONVERT_EXT_2_INT             Conversion from External to Internal Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I CONVERT_INT_2_EXT             Conversion from Internal to External Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Key Component                                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Access Method for Text (Read)                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I GET_LABELS                    Access Method for Interface Texts (Read)                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNT  I GET_VALUES                    Access Method for Values (Read)                             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_COMPNTS I GET_ALL                       Access Method for All Key Components for Category           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I BUILD_MAPPING_EXT_2_INT       Generate Mapping Between Key Components                     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CHECK                         Check key                                                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CONVERT_EXT_2_INT             Conversion from External to Internal Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CONVERT_EXT_RANGE_2_INT_TAB   Convert Key Attribute Range from External to Internal Format.
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CONVERT_EXT_TAB_2_INT_TAB     Conversion from External to Internal Format (Several Keys)  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CONVERT_INT_2_EXT             Conversion from Internal to External Format                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CONVERT_INT_TAB_2_EXT_TAB     Conversion from Internal to External Format (Several Keys)  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Proxy Object                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_TYPE_PROXY   I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_USAGE        I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Key Usage                                            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_USAGE        I GET_DESCRIPTION               Access Method for Description                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_USAGES       I GET_ALL                       Access Method to All Key Usages (Reading)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_KEY_USAGES       I GET_BY_KEY_USAGE              Access Method to Key Usages with Usage (Reading)            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I CREATE_ATTRIBUTES             Creation of Link Data                                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I CREATE_ATTRIBUTES_LOCAL       Creation of Local Link Data                                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Relationship                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I DELETE_LOCAL                  Delete Link (Local)                                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Access Method for Attributes (Read)                         .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I GET_ATTRIBUTES_LOCAL          Access Method for Local Attributes (Read)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I GET_ATTRIBUTES_OF_ALL_IMAGES  Access Method for All Attributes (Read)                     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I HAS_LOCAL_ATTRIBUTES          Is Local Link Data Available?                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Can Link Be Changed?                                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I RESET_ATTRIBUTES_LOCAL        Reset Local Link Data                                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Access Method for Link Data                                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK             I SET_ATTRIBUTES_LOCAL          Access Method for Local Link Data                           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINKS            I GET_ALL                       Access Method for All Links (Reading)                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_FACTORY     I BUILD_LINK                    Create Link (DO NOT USE)                                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_FACTORY     I CREATE_LINK                   Create Link (DO NOT USE)                                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_FACTORY     I GET_LINK_MANAGER              Access Method for Administration of Links (Read)            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_FACTORY     I SET_LINK_MANAGER              Access Method for Administration of Links (Write)           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINK                      Access Method for Link Data (DO NOT USE)                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINKS                     Access Method for Link Collection (Read)                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINKS_BY_COMPLEX_SELECTIONAccess Method for Links (DO NOT USE)                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINKS_BY_PRODUCT          Access Method for Links to Product (DO NOT USE)             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINKS_BY_PRODUCT_LOCAL    Access Method for Local Link Data (DO NOT USE)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINKS_BY_PRODUCT_SET_LOCALAccess Method for Local Link Data (DO NOT USE)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINK_FACTORY              Access Method for Link Factory (Read)                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINK_LOCAL                Access Method for Local Link Data ( DO NOT USE)             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I GET_LINK_PERSISTENCY          Access Method for Persistence of Links (Read)               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I IS_LINK_FOR_PRODUCT_CHANGEABLECan Link Be Changed for Specific Product? (DO NOT USE)      .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I REPLICATE_LINKS_FOR_OBJECT    Duplicate Links for Object (Identified by Key)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I REPLICATE_LINKS_FOR_PRODUCT   Duplicate Links for Product (Identified By Key)             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I RESET_LINKS                   Reset Link Data (DO NOT USE)                                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_MANAGER     I RESET_LINKS_LOCAL             Reset Local Link Data (DO NOT USE)                          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_PERSISTENCY I GET_LINK_MANAGER              Access Method for Administration of Links (Read)            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_LINK_PERSISTENCY I SET_LINK_MANAGER              Access Method for Administration of Links (Write)           .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_METADATA_MANAGER I GET_KEY_COMPONENTS            Access Method for Collection for Key Components             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_METADATA_MANAGER I GET_KEY_TYPES                 Access Method for Collection for Key Categories             .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_METADATA_MANAGER I GET_KEY_USAGES                Access Method to Collection for Key Usages                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_PERSISTENCY      I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check Changes                                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_PERSISTENCY      I HAS_CHANGES                   Have Changes Been Made?                                     .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_PERSISTENCY      I INITIALIZE_AFTER_COMMIT       Initialization After Commit Work                            .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_PERSISTENCY      I INITIALIZE_AFTER_ROLLBACK     Initialization After Rollback Work                          .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_PERSISTENCY      I SAVE_CHANGES                  Save Changes                                                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBCOMPONENT     I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check Changes                                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBCOMPONENT     I DISMISS_CHANGES               Reject Changes                                              .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBCOMPONENT     I HAS_CHANGES                   Have Changes Been Made to the Subcomponent?                 .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBCOMPONENT     I SAVE_CHANGES                  Save Changes                                                .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBSYSTEM        I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LH_SUBSYSTEM        I GET_INSTANCE                  Access Method for Instance (Singleton) (Read)               .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check Changes                                               .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I DISMISS_CHANGES               Reject Changes                                              .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_INSTANCE                  Access Method for Singleton (Read)                          .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEYS_BY_ATTRIBUTES        Access Method for Keys (Identified By Attributes)           .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEYS_BY_GUID              Access Method for Keys with GUID (Read)                     .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEYS_FOR_PRODUCT          Access Method for Keys for Product (Read)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_BY_ATTRIBUTES         Access Method for Key (Identified by Attributes)            .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_BY_GUID               Access Method for Key with GUID (Read)                      .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_TYPE                  Access Method for Key Type (Read)                           .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_TYPES                 Access Method for All Key Types (Read)                      .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_USAGE                 Access Method to Key Usage (Reading)                        .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I GET_KEY_USAGES                Access Method to All Key Usages (Reading)                   .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I HAS_CHANGES                   Have Changes Been Made?                                     .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I REPLICATE_LINKS_FOR_OBJECT    Duplicate Links for Object (Identified by Key)              .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I REPLICATE_LINKS_FOR_PRODUCT   Duplicate Links for Product (Identified By Key)             .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I SAVE_CHANGES                  Save Changes                                                .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER        I TRANSFORM_KEY_ATTRIBUTES_TABLETransform Key Attribute (Internal) from Table to Line       .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER_INT    I GET_KEY_MANAGER               Access Method for Differentiation Key Management            .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER_INT    I GET_LINK_MANAGER              Access Method for Management of Links                       .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER_INT    I GET_METADATA_MANAGER          Access Method for Management of Metadata                    .
IF_COM_PRD_LINK_HANDLER_INT    I IS_OO_LINK_MANAGEMENT_ACTIVE  Is Object-Oriented Link Management Active?                  .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I ADD_TO_CHANGED_COMPONENTS     Product Maintenance: Prepare PRODCUT_MNT_UPD                .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I APPEND_TO_MINITP_DATA_TAB     Attaches a Line to the Mini-Template Data                   .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CHECK_MINITP_REL_DATA         Checks the Data of a Mini-Template Grouping                 .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CHECK_OWN_DATA_LOGSYS         Product Maintenance: Check Whether Own Data with Ext.Log.Sys.
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CLEAR_KEY_MANAGER_ENTRIES     Deletes a Key for Buffer Entry Key Manager                  .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CONVERT_DATA_EXT              Converts Data into External Format                          .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CONVERT_ENTERED_KEYS_INT      Converts Data Entered into Internal Format                  .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I CONVERT_MODIFIED_DATA_INT     Converts Changed Data into External Format                  .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_CURRENT_ORG_ID            Gets the Current Organization ID or Differentiation Key     .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_KEY_MANAGER_ENTRY         Reads a Buffer Entry from the Key Manager                   .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_KEY_MANAGER_KEY           Determines a Key for Buffer Entry Key Manager               .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_ORG_TYPE                  Returns Organization Type                                   .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_PRODUCT_GUID              Returns Product GUID                                        .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_REL_TAB_DELTA             Determine Delta of two REL Link Handler Tables              .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_SETTYPE_GUID              Returns Set Type GUID of the Handle                         .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I GET_TFW_INFO                  Returns Information on Data Origin                          .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I MAKE_MINITP_REL_DATA_UPDTAB   API: Creates the Update Table Before Updating               .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I MAP_MINITP_REL_DATA           API: Converts Mini-Template Grouping Data to API Format     .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I PREPARE_PRODUCT_MNT_UPD       Prod.Comp-Spec.Impl.: Distribute Changes to Object Instances.
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I PRODUCT_MAINTAIN_PREFETCH     Link Handler-Specific Impl.: Initial Load of Refereced Data .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I READ_MINITP_REL_DATA          Returns the Entries of the Link Handler-Specific Link Table .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I READ_MINITP_REL_HISTORY_DATA  Gets the Entries of Link Handler-Specific Link History      .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I SET_AFFECTED_ORG_IDS          Prod.Comp-Spec. Impl.: Org_IDs Affected  During MTP Change  .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I SET_KEY_MANAGER_ENTRY         Set Buffer-Entry from Key Manager                           .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I SWITCH_TO_OWN                 Product Maintenance: Switch to Own-Product Data of Set Types.
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I SWITCH_TO_REF                 Product Maintenance: Switch to Referenced Data of Set Types .
IF_COM_PRD_TFW_HANDLE_SET      I UPDATE_MINITP_REL_DATA        API: Update Mini-Template Grouping Data                     .
IF_COM_PRD_UPGRADE             I CHECK_UPGRADE                 Check Whether the Upgrade Method Has To Be Executed         .
IF_COM_PRD_UPGRADE             I DO_UPGRADE                    Upgrade Method                                              .
IF_COM_PRODUCT_SE              I ENGINE_ATTRIBUTE_QUERY        Execute Search via Attributea (Advanced Search)             .
IF_COM_PRODUCT_SE              I ENGINE_ATTRIBUTE_READ         Read Attributes via Search Engine                           .
IF_COM_PRODUCT_SE              I ENGINE_STRING_QUERY           Map String to Various Attributes ("Google-Like")            .
IF_COM_PRSEARCHFILTER          I RELEVANT_CRITERIA             Output of Criteria Relevant for This Filter                 .
IF_COM_PRSEARCHTOOL            I RELEVANT_CRITERIA             Output of Criteria Relevant for This Tool                   .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I CHECK_DATA                    Checks Buffer                                               .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I FREE_BUFFER                   Deletes Buffer                                              .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I GET_CHANGES                   Determines Changed Data                                     .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets Instance                                               .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I LOCK                          Blocks Table                                                .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I MAINTAIN_UPDATE               Receives Changed Data                                       .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I READ_ALL                      Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I READ_ALL_M                    Reads All Entries from Maintenance Buffer                   .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I READ_SINGLE                   Reads All Entries from Checked Buffer                       .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I READ_SINGLE_M                 Reads an Entry from the Maintenance Buffer                  .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I SAVE                          Saves the Changed Data                                      .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I UNLOCK                        Unlocks Table                                               .
IF_COM_PR_ORG_REL_REPOSITORY   I UPDATE_CHK_BUFFER             Fills Checked Buffer from Maintenance Buffer                .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Check Object List for Display Authorization for Logon User  .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I CLEAN_UP                      Release Data, Recreate Initial Status                       .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NAME_LIST       Attributes for an Object Type                               .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Attribute Values and Content for Objects                    .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I GET_NUMBER_OF_OBJECTS         Number of Objects for an Object Type                        .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I GET_OBJECT_ID_LIST            Object IDs for an Object Type                               .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ               I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_LIST          Implemented Object Types                                    .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_NAME_ASSIST   I ADD_ATTRIBUTE_NAME            Add an Attribute                                            .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_NAME_ASSIST   I CLEAN_UP                      Clear Up the Assistants                                     .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_NAME_ASSIST   I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NAME_LIST       Deliver List of Attributes                                  .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_REL           I GET_RELATIONS                 Get Relation Instances of Relation Type                     .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_REL           I GET_REL_TYPE                  Get Relation Type Definition for Relation Type Key          .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_REL           I GET_REL_TYPE_KEYS             Get Keys of outgoing Relation Types                         .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I ADD_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Add a Value                                                 .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I ADD_CONTENT                   Add Content                                                 .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I ADD_OBJECT                    Add a New Object                                            .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I ADD_ROW                       Add a New Line                                              .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I ADD_TIMESTAMP                 Add a Time Stamp                                            .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I CLEAN_UP                      Clear Up the Assistant                                      .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Deliver List of Attribute Values                            .
IF_COM_SE_BUSOBJ_VALUE_ASSIST  I IS_REQUESTED                  Is the Attribute in an Attribute List?                      .
IF_COM_SE_F4_RESULT_ITEMS      I MODIFY_RESULT_ITEMS           Modify the result item list                                 .
IF_COM_SE_F4_STEP_SELONE       I MODIFY_COLLECTIVE_SEARCHHELP  Modify collective searchhelp                                .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I CREATE_INDEX                  Create Index                                                .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I CREATE_JOIN_INDEX             Create Join Index                                           .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I DELETE_INDEX                  Delete Index                                                .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I FEED_INDEX                    Feed Index (= Index/Deindex Documents/Objects)              .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I FLUSH_QUEUES                  Trigger Flush of Index Queues                               .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I GET_ATTRIBUTE_TYPE            Determine TREX attribute type from DDIC type                .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Fetching Instance (Singleton)                               .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I GET_QUEUES                    Get Status of Index Queues                                  .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I INDEX_EXISTS                  List of Indexes with their return code                      .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I SEARCH_DOCUMENTS              Search for Documents/Objects                                .
IF_COM_SE_TREX                 I SET_QUEUE_PARAMETERS          Set Queue Parameter(s)                                      .
IF_COM_STA                     I STATUS_CHANGE                 Change Status of an Object State                            .
IF_COM_STA                     I STATUS_PROVIDE                Get Status of an Object (State)                             .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I GET_TKOMK                     Get Communication Data (Header)                             .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I GET_TKOMP                     Get Communication Data (Item)                               .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I GET_TKOMV                     Get Conditions                                              .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I SET_TKOMK                     Set Communication Data (Header)                             .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I SET_TKOMP                     Set Communication Data (Item)                               .
IF_CONDITIONS_SA_MM            I SET_TKOMV                     Set Conditions (Without Check)                              .
IF_CONDITION_CONTAINER_PPF     I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns the Container                                       .
IF_CONDITION_CONTAINER_PPF     I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets a New Container                                        .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I COPY_CONDITION                Copies the Condition                                        .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I EVALUATE                      Evaluates the Condition                                     .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I EVALUATE_OPTIMIZATION_RULE    Evaluates the Optimization Rule                             .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers a Condition Object Instance                        .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I GET_TYPE                      Delivers the Type of the Determination Technology           .
IF_CONDITION_PPF               I SET_GUIDS                     Sets the Unique IDs of the Condition                        .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I CHECK_CONDITION               Checks the Condition                                        .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I COPY_CONDITION                Copies the Condition                                        .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I DELETE_CONDITION              Deletes the Condition                                       .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_CHANGED                   Delivers Changed Flag                                       .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_DESCRIPTION               Delivers the Description of the Condition                   .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_GUIDS                     Delivers the Unique IDs of the Condition                    .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers an Instance to Condition Management                .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_SCHEDULE_COND_SUBSCREEN   Delivers Subscreen for Schedule Condition                   .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_START_COND_SUBSCREEN      Delivers Subscreen for Start Condition                      .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I GET_TYPE                      Delivers the Type of the Determination Technology           .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I SET_GUIDS                     Sets the Unique IDs of the Condition                        .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I SET_MODE                      Sets the Mode (Display/Change)                              .
IF_CONDITION_VIEW_PPF          I TRANSPORT_CONDITION           Transports Additional Data                                  .
IF_CONNECT_NEW_OBJECTS         I INSERT_ADDITIONAL_ENTRIES     Get Relationship Texts for Instance                         .
IF_CONTAINER_ITEM              I GET_ITEMS                     Returns the Browser Item Contained Within                   .
IF_CONTAINER_ITEM              I SET_ITEMS                     Sets the Browser Item Contained Within                      .
IF_CONTROLLER_BRF              I CREATE_CONTROLLER             Creates a Controller                                        .
IF_CONTROLLER_BRF              I FREE                          Releases Controller Instance                                .
IF_CONTROLLER_BRF              I GET_EVENT                     Returns an Event Object                                     .
IF_CONTROLLER_BRF              I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Controller                                  .
IF_CONTROLLER_BRF              I PROCESS_EVENT                 Processes BRF Event                                         .
IF_CONTROL_AREA_MAPPABLE_S2L   I ACTIVATE                      Activates Control                                           .
IF_CONTROL_AREA_MAPPABLE_S2L   I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivate Control                                          .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I CREATE                        Generates a Plug-In at Runtime                              .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I CREATE_FOR_DESIGN             Generates a Plug-In at Design Time                          .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I CREATE_INITIAL                Generates an Initial Plug-In at Design Time                 .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I DELETE                        Destroys the Plug-In                                        .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I EDIT_PROPERTIES               Design-Time: Displays Dialog Box to Edit Attributes         .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_COMPOSITE_NAME            Returns Name of Associated Control Composite                .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_CONTROL_COMPOSITE         Run-time: Returns the Associated Control Composite          .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_DESIGNTIME_CONTROL        Design-time: Returns Reference to Dummy Control             .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_PLUG_IN_DESCRIPTION       Returns Information on Plug-In                              .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_PROPERTIES                Design-Time: Returns Plug-In Attributes as a String         .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PLUG_IN   I GET_RUNTIME_CONTROL           Runtime: Returns Reference to Top-Level-Control             .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PROP_LIST I CREATE_AND_INSERT             Inserts Node in the Property List Before Node Given         .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_PROP_LIST I REMOVE                        Removes Node from Property List                             .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORT   I DELETE                        Destroys Control                                            .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORT   I GET_ENUM_DESCRIPTION          Returns Table of ENUM Constants, Values, and Short Texts    .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORT   I GET_GUI_CONTAINER             Returns GUI Container for Given Container Node              .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORT   I SET_PROPERTY                  Updates Control Property of Given Property Node             .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORTFA I CREATE                        Creates a Control at Design Time or Runtim                  .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORTFA I CREATE_INITIAL                Creates a Control (Only Needed at Design Time)              .
IF_CONTROL_COMPOSITE_SUPPORTFA I GET_CONTROL_DESCRIPTION       Returns Information on the Control                          .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_CONTAINER_NODE            Creates a New Container Node and Inserts it as a Subnode    .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_CONTROL_NODE              Creates a New Control Node and Inserts it as a Subnode      .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_EVENT_NODE                Creates a New Event Node and Inserts it as a Subnode        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_PROP_LIST_NODE            Creates a New Property List Node and Inserts it as a Subnode.
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_PROP_NODE                 Creates a New Property Node and Inserts it as a Subnode     .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I ADD_PROP_TREE_NODE            Creates a New Property Tree Node and Inserts it as a Subnode.
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_BOOLE_VALUE               Returns a Value of Boolean Type                             .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CHILD                     Returns a Subnode with Its Name (Can Be Blank)              .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns all Subnodes in Table                               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CLASS_NAME                Returns the Value of the Class Name Attribute               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_COMMENT                   Returns the Value of the Short Text Attribute               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns Container Node                                      .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CONTROL                   Returns a Control Node in a Container                       .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CONTROL_EVENTS            Returns Sub-Tree Nodes of Control-Specific Events           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_CONTROL_PROPS             Returns Sub-Tree Nodes of Control-Specific Properties       .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_ENUM_VALUE                Returns Value of Type Enum                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_FACTORY_CLASS_NAME        Returns Value of Factory Class Name Attribute               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_FIRST_CHILD               Returns First Subnode                                       .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_HANDLER                   Returns Name of Event Handler                               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_ICON_VALUE                Returns Value of Type Icon                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_INT_VALUE                 Returns Value of Type Integer                               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_LAST_CHILD                Returns Last Subnode                                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_NAME                      Returns Property Name                                       .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Same-Level Node                                .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_NEXT_STATE                Returns Property next_state                                 .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_NODE_TYPE                 Returns Numbered Types of Different Node Types              .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PARENT                    Returns the Super Node                                      .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns Previous Same-Level Node                            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_BOOLE_VALUE          Returns Boolean Type Value for Property Name Given          .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_ENUM_VALUE           Returns Enum Type Value for Property Name Given             .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_ICON_VALUE           Returns Icon Type Value for Property Name Given             .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_INT_VALUE            Returns Integer Type Value for Property Name Given          .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_NODE                 Returns Property Node for Name Given                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_STRING_VALUE         Returns String Type Value for Property Name Given           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_PROP_TEXT_VALUE           Returns Text Type Value for Property Name Given             .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_STRING_VALUE              Returns Value of Type String                                .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_SUBTYPE                   Returns Value of Type ENUM                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_TEXT_VALUE                Returns Value of Type Text                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_TYPE                      Returns Property Type (BOOLE, INT, and so on)               .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I GET_VALUE                     Returns Proverty Value of Type Given                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I IS_LEAF                       Returns TRUE ('X') if Node Has no Subnodes                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I IS_PROP_READ_ONLY             Returns TRUE ('X') if Property Cannot Be Changed            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I IS_READ_ONLY                  Returns TRUE ('X') if Node Cannot Be Changed                .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I REMOVE                        Removes Node                                                .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_BOOLE_VALUE               Saves Property Value of Type Boolean                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_CLASS_NAME                Saves Class Name Attribute                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_COMMENT                   Saves Short Text Attribute                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_ENUM_VALUE                Saves Property Value of Type Enum                           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_FACTORY_CLASS_NAME        Saves Factory Class Name Attribute                          .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_HANDLER                   Saves Event Handler Name                                    .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_ICON_VALUE                Saves Property Value of Type Icon                           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_INT_VALUE                 Saves Property Value of Type Integer                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_NAME                      Saves Property Name                                         .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_NODE_TYPE                 Saves Type of Different Property Nodes                      .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_READ_ONLY                 Sets Property to "Changeable" or "Not Changeable"           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_STRING_VALUE              Saves Property Value of Type String                         .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_SUBTYPE                   Saves Name of an ENUM Type                                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_TEXT_VALUE                Saves Property Value of Type Text                           .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_TYPE                      Saves Property Type (BOOLE, INT and so on)                  .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE           I SET_VALUE                     Saves Property Value of Type Entered                        .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I FIND                          Finds Node of Given Type and (Optionally) Name              .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_ATTR                  Gets Named Attribute of Associated DOM Node                 .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_ATTRS                 Gets Attributes of Associated DOM Node                      .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_NAME                  Gets Name of Associated DOM Node                            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_NODE                  Gets Associated DOM Node                                    .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_TEXT                  Gets Text of Associated DOM Node                            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I GET_DOM_TYPE                  Gets Type of Associated DOM Node                            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I SET_DOM_ATTR                  Sets Named Attribute of Associated DOM Node                 .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I SET_DOM_NAME                  Sets Name of Associated DOM Node                            .
IF_CONTROL_TREE_NODE_DIAG      I SHOW                          Shows Node (Subtree) Structure                              .
IF_CONTROL_VIEW_MM             I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CONTROL_VIEW_MM             I SET_CONTAINER                 Specify Container                                           .
IF_CON_FIN_BTA_GM_AT_DELEGATE  I DELEGATE_EXECUTE_POSTING      Delegates execute_posting to Accounting Engine              .
IF_CON_FIN_BTA_GM_AT_DELEGATE  I DELEGATE_POSTING              Delegates Posting to the Accounting Engine                  .
IF_CON_FIN_BTA_GM_AT_DELEGATE  I DELEGATE_PREPARE_POSTING      Delegates prepare_posting to Accounting Engine              .
IF_COPY_BCS                    I COPY                          Copies Itself                                               .
IF_COSTING_BOM_ALV_TREE_LINE   I GET_LINE                      Supplies a outtab line for ALV Tree                         .
IF_COSTING_NUMBER_CK           I POSTING                       Update an Entry                                             .
IF_COSTING_NUMBER_CK           I READ                          Read an Entry from the Database                             .
IF_COSTING_NUMBER_CK           I SELECT                        Selection of Entries                                        .
IF_COSTING_TRACE               I COLLECT_MESSAGES              Collect All Messages                                        .
IF_COSTING_TRACE               I INSERT_MESSAGE                Insertion of Message                                        .
IF_COSTING_TRACE               I MESSAGES_TO_LOG               Place the Messages Collected in Error Log                   .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I CLOSE                         Close Cost Estimate                                         .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I COMMIT_ALL                    Update All Changed Cost Estimates                           .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I COPY                          Copy Cost Estimate                                          .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I CREATE                        Create Cost Estimate                                        .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I DELETE                        Delete Cost Estimate from Memory                            .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Cost Estimate                                        .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I ENQUEUE                       Lock Cost Estimate                                          .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I GET_ERROR_LOG                 Read Log Handle and Possibly Log from DB                    .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I READ_FOR_CHANGE               Read Cost Estimate Locked                                   .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I READ_FOR_DISPLAY              Read Cost Estimate Without Lock                             .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I REOPEN                        Reopen Cost Estimate                                        .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I SAVE                          Save Cost Estimate on DB                                    .
IF_COST_ESTIMATE               I SAVE_TEMPORARILY              Temporarily Save Cost Estimate                              .
IF_CO_OBJECT_ITEM              I GET_CO_OBJECT_DATA            Prepare Data for CO Object                                  .
IF_CO_OBJECT_REFERENCE         I GET_AA_OBJECT_NUMBER          CO Object Number of Account Assignmt Object (Execution Serv).
IF_CO_OBJECT_REFERENCE         I GET_CO_OBJECT_DATA            Provide data                                                .
IF_CO_OBJECT_REFERENCE         I GET_CO_OBJECT_NUMBER          Read CO Object Number (is Called Before Update)             .
IF_CO_OBJECT_REFERENCE         I GET_TMP_CO_OBJECT_NUMBER      Read (Temporary) CO Object No.                              .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I CALCULATE_OVERHEAD            Calculates Overhead on Object                               .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I COLLECT_COSTS                 Cost Calculation                                            .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I DISPLAY_COSTING_DATA          Displays Cost Data (Possibly from DB)                       .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I EXPORT_TO_MEMORY              Exports the Data of the CO Object into Memory               .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I GET_OBJNR                     Supplies Object Number of Object                            .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I IMPORT_FROM_MEMORY            Imports CO Object from Memory                               .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I INIT                          Clear                                                       .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I RETURN_DATA                   Returns Cost Data                                           .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I RETURN_DELTAS                 Returns Deltas of Internal Tables to DB                     .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I SUMMARIZE_COSTS               Returns Costs as a Total (Possibly from DB)                 .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I SWITCH_NUMBER                 Change of (Temporary) Object Number                         .
IF_CO_PC_CO_OBJECT             I UPDATE                        Update to Database                                          .
IF_CPROJECT_PS_LINK            I GET_SCREEN_INSTANCE           Get subscreen program name and screen number                .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I CHECK_ACCOUNT                 Check Account Assignment Data                               .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I GET_DATA                      Read Account Assignment Data                                .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I GET_ITEM                      Determine Item                                              .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I GET_OLD_DATA                  Read New Account Assignment Data                            .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I SET_ACCOUNT_OK                Set Account Assignment to OK                                .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I SET_DATA                      Set Account Assignment Data                                 .
IF_CP_ACCOUNT_MM               I SET_KBLNR_KBLPOS              Set Earmarked Funds                                         .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I CHECK_VALUE                   Check Commitment Plan Value                                 .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I CREATE_NEW_ITEM               Create New Item                                             .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I DELETE_ITEM                   Delete Item                                                 .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_AKTYP                     Read Activity Category                                      .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_DATA                      Read Header Data                                            .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_EKKO                      Read Contract Header                                        .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_EKPO                      Read Contract Item                                          .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_ITEMS                     Read Commitment Plan Items                                  .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I GET_TRTYP                     Read Transaction Type                                       .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I PROCESS                       Process                                                     .
IF_CP_HEADER_MM                I SET_DATA                      Set Header Data                                             .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I CHECK_ITEM                    Check Item Value                                            .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I CREATE_NEW_ACC_ITEM           Generate New Account Assignment Item                        .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I DELETE_ACCOUNT                Delete Account Assignment                                   .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I DELETE_ALL_ACCOUNTS           Delete All Account Assignments                              .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I GET_ACCOUNTINGS               Determine Account Assignments                               .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I GET_DATA                      Read Item Data                                              .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I GET_HEADER                    Read Header Reference                                       .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I GET_OLD_DATA                  Read New Item Data                                          .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I SET_DATA                      Set Item Data                                               .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I SET_ITEM_OK                   Set Item to OK                                              .
IF_CP_ITEM_MM                  I SET_KBLNR                     Set Earmarked Funds                                         .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I COPY_BLVIEW                   Copy Current View to New View                               .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I DELETE                        Delete Application (Only Contents of C Tables)              .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I DEL_BLUEPRINT                 Delete Blueprint Entry                                      .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I EXIT                          Delete Temporary Work Data from Database                    .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_BLAPPL                    Request Application/Application Set                         .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_BLUEPRINT                 Return Blueprint Entry                                      .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_BLVIEW                    Return View                                                 .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_BSP_EVENT_TXT             Event Text                                                  .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_BSP_MULTIGRP              Get Keys and Text for Multigroup                            .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_DESIG_URL                 Determine URL for Calling the Designer                      .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_EVENT_POOL                Tabstrip Event Without Event Set                            .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I GET_EVENT_SET                 Tabstrip Event                                              .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I IS_MODIFIED                   Check to See if Data Was Changed                            .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I LOAD                          Load Data from Database                                     .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I SAVE                          Save Data to Database                                       .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I SAVE_AS                       Save Data to Database under New Name                        .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I SET_BLUEPRINT                 Create/Change Blueprint Entry                               .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I SET_BLVIEW                    Set view                                                    .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I SET_TRREQUEST                 Copy Request Number for Transport                           .
IF_CRM_BAB_BLUEPRINT           I UNDO                          Undo Changes                                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_BP_POPUP_CLIENT     I BP_SELECTED                   BP Selected on Popup                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_COMM_CONT           I GET_OBJECTKEY_TAB             Determination of Object Key Table                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_COMM_CONT           I SET_OBJECTKEY_TAB             Sets Object Key Table                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I ADD_CHILD                     Adds the specified child to this container.                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I DELETE                        Deletes this container from the data store.                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns value of specified attribute (non case-sensitive).  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the values of the specified attributes.             .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_ATTRIBUTE_CS              Returns value of specified attribute (case-sensitive).      .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CHANGED_BY                Returns this container's last change user.                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CHANGED_ON                Returns this container's last change date.                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CHILD                     Returns a named child of this container.                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns the children of this container.                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CREATED_BY                Returns this container's creator.                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_CREATED_ON                Returns this container's creation date.                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_FORMAT                    Returns this container's format.                            .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_GUID                      Returns the GUID of this container.                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_NAME                      Returns the name of this container.                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_PARENT                    Returns this container's parent container.                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I GET_PARENT_GUID               Returns the GUID of this container's parent.                .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I INITIALIZE                    Initializes this container or loads it from a data store.   .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I IS_PERSISTENT                 Returns 'X' if the container should be saved to the database.
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I RELEASE                       Releases the memory occupied by this container.             .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE              Removes the specified attribute.                            .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTES             Removes all the attributes of this container.               .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I REMOVE_CHILD                  Removes the named child of this container.                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I REMOVE_CHILD_REF              Removes a reference to a child (does not remove the child). .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SAVE                          Saves this container to a data store.                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets the value of the specified attribute.                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets the values of the specified attributes.                .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_FORMAT                    Sets this container's format.                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_NAME                      Sets the name of this container.                            .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_PARENT_REF                Sets this container's parent reference.                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_CONTAINER           I SET_PERSISTENT                Sets whether the container should be saved to the database. .
IF_CRM_BSP_CT_DBAL_APPL        I COPY_TO_APPL                  Copy receiver to new application                            .
IF_CRM_BSP_CT_DBAL_FIELDGROUP  I COPY_TO_FIELDGROUP            Copy receiver to new fieldgroup                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_CT_DBAL_TABGROUP    I COPY_TO_TABGROUP              Copy receiver to new tabgroup                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_CT_DBAL_TLBGROUP    I COPY_TO_TOOLBARGROUP          Copy receiver to new toolbar group                          .
IF_CRM_BSP_FACE_RENDERABLE     I RENDER                        Render                                                      .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I DO_GET_DATA                   Data Collection                                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I GET_FIELDNAME_ID              Field Identification                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I GET_FOCUS_VALUES              Determine Focus Values                                      .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I GET_NEW_GLOBAL_EVENT          Determines New Event When Hiding Active Tab                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I GET_OBJECT_KEY_TAB            Determination of Object Key Table                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I GET_VISIBLE_OBJECT_KEYS       Determine Object Key According to Filter                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I SET_CURSOR_FIELDNAME          Determine Field Name in Which Cursor Is Placed              .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I SET_FOCUS_OBJECT              Set Focus                                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I SET_FW_MSGS_TO_APPLOG         Sets Framework Messages in Application Log                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I SET_OBJECT_KEY_TAB            Set Table of Object Keys                                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_COM           I SET_PRINT_DATA                Determine Data for Printing                                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_OIC_CAL       I GET_INITIAL_CALENDAR_DATA     Get calendar data for the first run                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_FRAME_OIC_CAL       I SET_CALENDAR_DATA             Set calendar data in the search request controller.         .
IF_CRM_BSP_INIT_IL             I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_ITERATOR            I HAS_NEXT                      Indicates if more elements lie in the forward direction.    .
IF_CRM_BSP_ITERATOR            I NEXT                          Returns the next element in the list.                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_ITERATOR            I REMOVE                        Optional. Removes the last returned element.                .
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I ADD                           Optional. Inserts an element into the next position.        .
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I HAS_PREVIOUS                  Indicates if more elements lie in the backward direction.   .
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I NEXT_INDEX                    Returns the index of the item that next() will returned.    .
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I PREVIOUS                      Returns the previous element in the list.                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I PREVIOUS_INDEX                Returns the index of the item that previous() will returned..
IF_CRM_BSP_LIST_ITERATOR       I SET                           Optional. Replaces the last returned element.               .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_CHANGE_ONLY               Attribute: Change Only                                      .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_MULTIEDIT_OIC             Attribute: OIC in Multi-Edit Mode                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_NOMARK                    Attribute: No Selection Column                              .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_OICONLY                   Attribute: OIC Only                                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_SRID                      Attribute: SRID                                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MAIN_PROPERTY       I GET_STANDALONE                Attribute: Standalone                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I AFTER_ROLLBACK_DELETE         Deletion Failed                                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHANGE_FOCUS                  Change Focus                                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_MULTIGROUP       Read Active Subcontroller                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_SHUFFLER         Check Active Shuffler                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_STEPS            Read Active Steps                                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP         Reading the Active Tabs                                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_TOOLBAR          Read Active Pushbuttons                                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_ACTIVE_VIEWSETGROUP     Read Active Viewsets                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CHECK_BEFORE_DELETE           Check if Deletion is Allowed                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CONVERT_FROM_BOR              Determination of Object Key from BOR Parameters             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I CONVERT_TO_BOR                Determination of BOR Parameters from Object Key             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I FILL_DROPDOWN_LISTBOX         Read Dropdown Listbox Values                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I FILL_EVENTGROUP               Read Dynamic Events                                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_ALLOWED_DDLB_VALUES       Fill Values for Drop-Down List Box Depending on Object Key  .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_FIELDGROUP_VARIANT        Read Field Group Variants                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_MESSAGES                  Read Error Messages                                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_MY_FAVORITES              Determine Favorites                                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_PARENT_OBJECT_KEY         Determine Higher-Level Object Key                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I GET_VARIANT                   Read Screen Variants                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I IS_OBJECT_IN_CREATE_MODE      Is Object in Create Mode?                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I PROCESS_EVENT                 Event Execution                                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I QUERY                         Start Search                                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I READ                          Read Data                                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I READ_FOCUS_OBJECT             Read Data (with Focus Object)                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I SET_SELECTED_PROCESS_ID       Set Selected Process ID                                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I SET_SELECTED_STEP_ID          Set Selected Step ID                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL     I SET_URL_PARAMETER             Set URL Parameters for Events                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I CHECK_ACTIVE_SHUFFLER         Check Active Shuffler                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I FILL_F4_STRUCTURE             Fill value help (F4) structure values                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I FILL_MASS_UPDATE_ATTRIBUTES   Do not use it! It is useless now!                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I GET_URL_PARAMETERS            Read URL parameters on Requests                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I QUERY                         Suche starten                                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I QUERY_BY_EXTINDEX             Obsolete. Please use IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_SRCH_EXTIN_IL         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_2   I READ_BY_EXTINDEX              Obsolete. Please use IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_SRCH_EXTIN_IL         .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_3   I READ_FOCUS_OBJECT_LI          Read Data from MAC with focus object and locking information.
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_ACCESS_IL_3   I READ_LI                       Read Data from MAC with locking information                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_FASTSEARCH_IL I QUERY_FAST                    Query with Fast Search Attributes                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_SRCH_EXTIN_IL I QUERY_BY_EXTINDEX             By Attribute (TRex) Fast Search Query                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_SRCH_EXTIN_IL I QUERY_BY_STRING               By String (TRex) Fast Search Query                          .
IF_CRM_BSP_MODEL_SRCH_EXTIN_IL I READ_BY_EXTINDEX              By Attribute (TRex) Fast Search Read                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I CHECK_FULL_WIDTH              Check Whether Controller Covers Full Screen Width           .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I CHECK_TABLE_HEADER_NECESSITY  Transfer Table Header                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I CHECK_TABSTRIP_NECESSITY      Check Whether Tabstrips Should Be Displayed                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I GET_BLUEPRINT_ENTRY           Determines Blueprint Attribute                              .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I GET_GV_VIEWSTATE_OIC          Determine Expand/Collapsed Status                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I GET_OBJECT_KEY                Determines Object Key                                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I GET_PROPERTY_OBJECT           Attributes                                                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I GET_VISIBLE_OBJECT_KEYS       Determines Object Key According to Filter Criteria          .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SEND_PTC                      Sends a Data Loss Popup                                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_CURSOR_COMPONENT          Set Information for Cursor Placement                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_FOCUS_ATTRIBUTES          Set Focus Attributes in Main                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_JAVASCRIPT                Transfer of Statistical and Dynamic JavaScript              .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_JS_FOR_NAV                Set JavaScript for Navigation                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_MULTIPART                 Set Multipart                                               .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_PRINT_DATA                Determine Data for Printing                                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM          I SET_REQUIRED_FIELD_IDS        Transfer Mandatory Field IDs                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I CLEAR_GT_MSELVALUES           Clear table with multiselect name-value pairs               .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I EVENTGRP_POPUP_SHOWN          Whether Event Group Popup is shown for quick create.        .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I FILL_GT_MULTISELECT_VALUES    Fill table with multiselect name-value pairs                .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_CONTROLLER                Wrapper method for CL_BSP_CONTROLLER2                       .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_F4CS_EVENT                Gets context sensitive value help event                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_F4CS_VALUE                Gets context sensitive value help attribute                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_FLOORPLAN_VERSION         Gets the Version of Floor Plan                              .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_GT_MSELVALUES             Gets table with multiselect name-value pairs                .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_NFP_VIEW_MODE             Gets View Mode Attribute                                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I GET_URL_PARAMETER_VALUE       Gets the value of a specific URL parameter                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I IN_ODP1_GEN_TAB               Whether the ODP tab is the 'General Tab'                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I SET_F4CS_VALUE                Sets context sensitive value help attribute                 .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I SET_NFP_VIEW_MODE             Sets view mode attribute                                    .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I SET_OBJECT_KEY_TAB            Sets the Object Key table                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_PARENT_COM_2        I SET_OIP_CREATE_MODE           send the OIP's create mode                                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_PERSISTENCY_IL      I IS_NON_PERSISTENT             Allows MAC to signal that object keys are non-persistent    .
IF_CRM_BSP_PROCESS_IL          I AFTER_ROLLBACK                Time for Initializiation After Rollback                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_PROCESS_IL          I AFTER_SAVE                    Time for Initialization After Saving                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_PROCESS_IL          I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Time for Check Before Saving                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_PROCESS_IL          I GET_PRIORITY                  Priority for Saving (1=high, 9=low)                         .
IF_CRM_BSP_PROCESS_IL          I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_CRM_BSP_QUICKCREATE_COM     I SAVE                          Execute SAVE                                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_SEARCHREQ_COM       I GET_SEARCHREQ_MODE            Determine Search Status                                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_APPL_BUTTONS              Get Application Functions                                   .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_APPL_DDLB_ITEMS           Application Function DDLB Items                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_DATATABLE_METADATA        Determine Data Table Structure                              .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_QUERYSTRING               Determine Query String from Object Key                      .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_SREQ_METADATA             Determine Search Request Structure                          .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I GET_SRES_METADATA             Determine Search Result Structure                           .
IF_CRM_BSP_SMP_MODEL_ACCESS    I HANDLE_EVENT                  Execute Application Function                                .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I COPY                          Copies Selected Node and Subordinate Objects                .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I CUT                           Cuts Selected Node and Subordinate Objects                  .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Fetch Field Attributes for Selected Row in ODC Tree         .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I PASTE                         Pastes Cut or Copied Branch Under Focus                     .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I READ_CHILDREN                 Reads Subordinate Nodes in Tree                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I READ_ROOT_DESCR               Reads Node Description for Tree                             .
IF_CRM_BSP_TREETABLE_IL        I REFRESH                       Refresh Tree , i.e. Call Up READ Again?                     .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_ATTRIBUTES                returns all attributes to specific user                     .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_CALLS                     returns all relevant information about phone call           .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_CALL_ATTRIBUTES           returns all relevant information about an ongoing phone call.
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_CHAT_SES                  returns all relevant information about chat_ses             .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_MESSAGES                  returns all relevant information about messages             .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_POSTING                   returns all information to special posting                  .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I GET_SESSIONS                  get all chat sessions of a user                             .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I SET_ADDRESSES                 sets addresses of the user                                  .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I SET_CURRENT_CHANNELS          sets current channels of user                               .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I SET_CURRENT_QUEUES            sets current queues of user                                 .
IF_CRM_CCS_DB                  I SET_CURRENT_WORKMODE          sets current workmode of user                               .
IF_CRM_CHECK_RESULT_VALID      I CHECK_VALIDITY_OF_CHECK_RESULTDetermine If Check Result Is Still Valid                    .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I CLOSE                         close connection                                            .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I DIALOG                        process dialog                                              .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I DO_RESTART                    restart application                                         .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I END_ACTIVE_CONTACT            end active contact                                          .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I GET_CONCURRENCY               Get concurrency                                             .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I GET_INFORMATION               get information                                             .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I INITIALIZE                    initialize                                                  .
IF_CRM_CIC_ASP_APPLICATION     I SET_XTRIGGER_INWAIT           Set flag for triggering INWAIT when entering a client       .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I ADD_ELEMENTS                  Put elements to BDD                                         .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I GET_ELEMENTS                  Get all elements from BDD                                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I REMOVE_ALL                    Clears BDD                                                  .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I REMOVE_ELEMENTS               Remove elements from BDD                                    .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I SET_EVENT_GATE                Sets the object to subscribe for events                     .
IF_CRM_CIC_BDD                 I SET_MARKED_ELEMENTS           Set which elements are selected                             .
IF_CRM_CIC_CARGO               I ADD_ITEM                      Add any named value to cargo                                .
IF_CRM_CIC_CARGO               I GET_ITEM                      Get any named value from cargo                              .
IF_CRM_CIC_CARGO               I GET_ITEM_LIST                 Get a list of all names of cargo values                     .
IF_CRM_CIC_CARGO               I REMOVE_ALL_ITEMS              Remove all named values from cargo                          .
IF_CRM_CIC_CARGO               I REMOVE_ITEM                   Remove any named value from cargo                           .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_CUST         I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA_SOURCE    adds additonal data source elements to action box data flow .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_CUST         I GET_CALL_GROUPS               returns call groups for action box definition               .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_CUST         I GET_CONFIGURATIONS            returns all configurations of a component workspace         .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_CUST         I GET_EXTERNAL_INTERFACE        returns the external interface of a component workspace     .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_EVENT_GATE   I ADD_LISTENER                  Registers component workspace for event                     .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_EVENT_GATE   I ADD_OKCODE_LISTENER           Registers component workspace for okcodes                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_EVENT_GATE   I REMOVE_ALL                    Removes all listeners of one object                         .
IF_CRM_CIC_CMPWSP_EVENT_GATE   I REMOVE_LISTENER               Removes listener for event                                  .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_ACT_HANDL   I EXECUTE_ACTION                Execites Default Action                                     .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_ACT_HANDL   I EXECUTE_DEFAULT_ACTION        Executes a Cluster Action                                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_ACT_HANDL   I GET_ACTIONS                   Provides List of Possible Actions for Cluster Type          .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_ACT_HANDL   I GET_ACTIONS_CTMENU            Creates Complete Context Menu (Alternative to GET_ACTIONS)  .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_ACT_HANDL   I GET_DEFAULT_ACTION            Provides Default Actions for Cluster Type                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_TOOLBAR     I GET_TOOLBAR_ACTIONS           Returns Description of Current Toolbar Actions              .
IF_CRM_CIC_NAVVIEW_TOOLBAR     I HANDLE_TOOLBAR_ACTION         Handles the triggering of a toolbar action by a user        .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I ADD_CHILD                     Add a subcluster to the cluster                             .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I BUILD                         Explicit request for building the cluster                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I CREATE_CHILD                  Add a new subcluster                                        .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I CREATE_CHILDREN_FROM_OBJECTS  Add multiple new subsclusters with reference to objects     .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I CREATE_CHILD_FROM_OBJECT      Add a new subcluster with reference to an object            .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I GET_ALL_CHILDREN              Get all children                                            .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I GET_CHILDREN_OF_TYPE          Get all children of a specific type                         .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I GET_NUMBER_OF_CHILDREN        Get the number of dependend subclusters                     .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I GET_NUMBER_OF_CHILDREN_AUTO   Get the number of dependend subclusters (automatically)     .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I GET_REF_OBJECT                Get the reference object of the cluster node                .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I IS_BUILT                      Return flag: Cluster is already built                       .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I IS_IGNORE                     Return flag for cluster client: Ignore this cluster         .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I IS_LINKED_TO_OBJECT           Return flag: Cluster has reference object                   .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I REMOVE_ALL_CHILDREN           Remove all children                                         .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I REMOVE_CHILD                  Remove one subcluster                                       .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I REMOVE_CHILDREN_OF_TYPE       Remove all children of a specific type                      .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I REMOVE_REF_OBJECT             Remove the reference object of the cluster                  .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I RESET_BUILT                   Reset flag: Cluster is already built                        .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I RESET_IGNORE                  Reset flag for cluster client: Ignore this cluster (use sub~.
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I RESET_TOUCHED                 Resets touched-flags of this cluster and all subclusters    .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I SET_BUILT                     Set flag: Cluster is already built                          .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I SET_CLUSTER_BUILDER           Set the cluster builder object                              .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I SET_IGNORE                    Set flag for cluster client: Ignore this cluster (use sub~) .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I SET_NUMBER_OF_CHILDREN        Sets the number of children                                 .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER          I SET_REF_OBJECT                Set the reference object of the cluster node                .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I BUILD_ON_CHILD_ACCESS         Build cluster on child request                              .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I BUILD_ON_REF_OBJECT_SET       Build cluster when the reference object is set              .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I BUILD_ON_REQUEST              Build cluster on explicit request                           .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I GET_CLUSTER_DEFINITION        Returns node types and structure                            .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I SET_ADDITIONAL_SELECTIONS     Sets additional selections for the cluster builder          .
IF_CRM_CIC_OP_CLUSTER_BUILDER  I SET_PROFILE                   Sets the profile of the cluster builder                     .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I AVAILABLE_LANGUAGES           Get a list of available languages for a knowledge base      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I DELETE                        Delete a list of knowledge entities                         .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I DELETE_ALL                    Delete a knowledge base                                     .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I DEQUEUE                       Dequeue kb table entries                                    .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I ENQUEUE                       Enqueue kb table entries                                    .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I ENTITY_TO_XML                 Convert a knowledge entity to xml format                    .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GENERATE                      Generate a list of knowledge entities                       .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GENERATE_ALL                  Generate a knowledge base                                   .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_ACCESS_INFO               Get access information                                      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITIONS     Get attribute definitions                                   .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_ATTRIBUTE_META            Get attribute set for a knowledge base                      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_ATTRIBUTE_SEARCH_RETURN   Get attribute name returned with search hitlist             .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Get attribute set with possible values for a knowledge base .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_CMDOCUMENTS               obtain attachment for specific kb                           .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_PARAMETERS                Get configuration parameters                                .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I GET_PATTERNS                  Get kb-specific patterns from attributes                    .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RESET_COMPILE_STATUS          Reset compilation status                                    .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE                      Retrieve a single knowledge entity                          .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_BATCH                Retrieve next batch of knowledge entities                   .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_BY_BO                Retrieve entities based on known business objects           .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_DETAIL               Retrieve details of a set of knowledge entities             .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_DETAIL_CONV          Retrieve details for conversion, attributes, texts and url  .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_DETAIL_XML           Retrieve details of knowledge entities in xml format        .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_HISTORY              Retrieve history of a knowledge entity                      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RETRIEVE_SET                  Retrieve a list of knowledge entities                       .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I RUN_XSLT                      Convert xml to a html via xslt                              .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I SET_ACCESS_INFO               Set values for access information                           .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I SET_ACCESS_INFO_DELTA         Increase/decease access information based on delta changes  .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I SET_DELTA_UPDATE              Set a set of object for delta update                        .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I SET_PARAMETERS                Set configuration parameters                                .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I UPDATE_ACTION                 Update todo actions after generation                        .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I UPDATE_AFTER_COMPILE          Update and reset actions after compilation is finished      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB                   I XML_TO_STRING                 Convert xml to a string                                     .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I CREATE_GENERATION_LOG         Create a log entry for full generation                      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I DELETE_GENERATION_LOG         Delete log entries for full generation                      .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_COMPILATION_LOG           Get logs for compilation history                            .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_COMPILED_PERCENTAGE       Percentage of compiled knowledge entities                   .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_GENERATED_PERCENTAGE      Percentage of generated knowldge entities                   .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_GENERATION_LOG            Get logs for generation history                             .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_UNCOMPILED_LIST           Get a list of uncompiled knowledge entities                 .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I GET_UNGENERATED_LIST          Get a list of ungenerated knowledge entities                .
IF_CRM_EI_KB_STAT              I SET_PARAMETERS                Set configurations for statistical information              .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I FEEDBACK                      Process feedbacks for recommendation                        .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I GET_ACTIONS                   Get all possible actions                                    .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I LEARN                         Incremental learn new information                           .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I RECOMMEND                     Recommend actions based on learned results                  .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I RESET                         Reset learning engine to its initial state                  .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I SET_ACTIONS                   Set all possible actions                                    .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I TRAIN                         Train the engine from large data sets                       .
IF_CRM_EI_LE                   I TUNE                          Tune learning parameters                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I GET_DDIC_DEFINITION           Return DDIC definition for a specific parameter             .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Get all export parameters                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETER_DETAILS  Get details for a specific export parameter                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I GET_IMPORT_PARAMETERS         Get all action import parameters                            .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I GET_IMPORT_PARAMETER_DETAILS  Get details for a specific action import parameter          .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I PREPARE_INTERFACE_INFORMATION Prepares interface description for paramter queries         .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I SET_EXPORT_PARAMETER_VALUES   Set a specific export parameter                             .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I SET_IMPORT_PARAMETER_VALUES   Set a specific action import parameter                      .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_GENERATION  I TRIGGER_GENERATION            Start generation                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I GET_DATA                      Get data via name                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I GET_DEFINITION_AS_STRING      Returns definition as string                                .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I RESET                         Reset in case of type change                                .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I SET_DATA                      Set name/value pair                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I SET_DATA_FROM_DEFINITION      Fills data based on definition                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I SET_DATA_FROM_DEFINITION_NEW  Fills data based on definition                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I SET_DATA_FROM_HANDLER         Fills data based on handler class                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ABOX_WIZ_TECH_DATA   I SET_DATA_FROM_HANDLER_NEW     Fills data based on handler class                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION               I ADD_APARAMETER                Add parameter                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION               I GET_ACTIONID                  Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION               I GET_APARAMETERS_LIST          Gets action parameters list                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION               I SET_ACTIONID                  Sets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I GET_ACTIONCLASS               Gets action class                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I GET_ID                        Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I GET_TYPE                      Gets type                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I SET_ACTIONCLASS               Sets action class                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I SET_ID                        Sets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_DEF           I SET_TYPE                      Sets type                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I BUILD_CONSTRUCTOR_CODE        Build code for action specific constructor                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I BUILD_DEFINITION_CODE         Build code for action definition retrieval                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I BUILD_PREPARE_CODE            Build code for data flow to the action                      .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I BUILD_RETURN_CODE             Build code for data flow from the action                    .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I CHECK_CLASS_FOR_REGENERATION  Check existing class if regeneration is possible            .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I GENERATE_CLASS                Generate class frame (data flow independent parts)          .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I GENERATE_SOURCES              Generate methods and local types                            .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I GET_COMPLETE_DF_AND_IFDEF     Get data flow and interface definition with details         .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I GET_DATA_FLOW                 Get available data flow (either initial or existing)        .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I GET_DDIC_DEFINITION           Returns DDIC definition for a specific parameter            .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I LOAD_ACTION_INTERFACE         Load action interface definitions                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I SET_COMPLETE_DF_AND_IFDEF     Set data flow and interface definition with details         .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_GENERATION    I SET_RETURN_DATA_FLOW_REQUEST  Defines if the return data flow should be executed          .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I GET_ACTION_PROPERTY           Returns action specific property (e.g. BOR object type)     .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I GET_DATA_FLOW                 Returns string containing the data flow in html code        .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I GET_FORMATTED_ACTION_TYPE     Returns action type formatted for ITS service               .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I GET_LOGSYS                    Returns the logical system                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I GET_OUTBOUND_PLUG             Returns the outbound plug name for navigation               .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I IS_DATA_FLOW_COMPLETE         True if data flow is complete and action should be executed .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I IS_RETURN_CONTAINER_REQUESTED True if ITS should return data container                    .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I PREPARE_DATA_FLOW             Builds and prepares data flow                               .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_HANDLER       I PROCESS_RETURN                Process the return data flow                                .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_REP           I ADD_ACTION_DEF                Adds action                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ACTION_REP           I GET_ACTIONS_LIST              Gets actions list                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_AC_DETERMINATION     I DETERMINE_COMPARE_VALUE       Determine value used for comparison                         .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I CHECK_HANDLER                 Check that  all handler attributes are accessible           .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I CREATE_DISPLAY_HANDLER        Create generic display handler                              .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I CREATE_HANDLER                Create specific action handler                              .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I GENERATE_HANDLER              Generate specific handler if needed                         .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I GET_HANDLER_DEFINITION        Get name/value table with handler definition                .
IF_CRM_IC_AHANDLER_FACTORY     I GET_HANDLER_GENERATOR         Get transaction specific generator reference                .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT                I EXECUTE                       process the alert message and send it to browser via SAM    .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I ADDTO_MESSAGE_HISTORY         Add to alert message history                                .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I ASSIGN_SAM_AGENT_QUEUE        Sets the value of sam agent session queue                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I ASSIGN_SAM_SENDER             Sets the value of SAM sender.                               .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I COMPOSE_MESSAGE_TEXT          compose alert message text                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I GET_ALERTS_FOR_EVENT          Get all alerts defined for the event                        .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I GET_MESSAGE_HISTORY           Get message history list                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I GET_SAM_AGENT_QUEUE           Get SAM agent session queue.                                .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I SEND_ALERT_CANCEL             Sends alert cancel message to browser                       .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I SEND_ALERT_MESSAGE            Send alert message to browser                               .
IF_CRM_IC_ALERT_SERVICE        I UNINIT                        Un-initialization                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I ADD_DYN_PAR                   Adds dynamic content parameter                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I ADD_ITEM                      Adds item                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_ANSWERID                  Gets answer id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_BOUNDTO                   Gets bound to BDC field                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_COLS                      Gets number of columns                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_DYNAMICCONTENTPROVIDERID  Gets dynamic content provider id                            .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_DYN_PAR_LIST              Gets parameter list                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_ISDYNAMIC                 Gets is dynamic answer flag                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_ITEMS_LIST                Gets items list                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_MAXLENGTH                 Gets length                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_ROWS                      Get number of rows                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_SIZE                      Gets size                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_STYLE                     Gets style                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_TEXTPOSITION              Gets text position                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I GET_TYPE                      Gets type                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_ANSWERID                  Sets answer id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_BOUNDTO                   Sets bound to BDC field                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_COLS                      Sets number of columns                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_DYNAMICCONTENTPROVIDERID  Sets dynamic content provider id                            .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_ISDYNAMIC                 Sets is dynamic answer flag                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_MAXLENGTH                 Sets length                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_ROWS                      Sets number of rows                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_SIZE                      Sets size                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_STYLE                     Sets style                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_TEXTPOSITION              Sets text position                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_ANSWER               I SET_TYPE                      Sets type                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_AUTOCUST_ITEM        I CREATE_ITEM                   create item                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_BADI_DEFAULT         I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_BOL_BOR_MAPPER       I CONVERT_BOL_TO_BOR            Get BOR key from BOL object                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_BOL_BOR_MAPPER       I CONVERT_BOR_TO_BOL            Get BOL key from BOR object                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_BSP_DYN_NAVLINK      I NAVIGATE                      Triggers navigation                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_BSP_INVOKE_HANDLER   I HANDLE_REQUEST                handles request                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_CALLBACK_REGISTRY    I REGISTER                      Register for callback                                       .
IF_CRM_IC_CALLBACK_REGISTRY    I UNREGISTER                    Un-register                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTER              I ADD_CHAPTERTITLE              Adds chapter                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTER              I GET_CHAPTERID                 Gets chapter id                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTER              I GET_CHAPTERTITLES_LIST        Gets titles list                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTER              I SET_CHAPTERID                 Sets chapter id                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTERTITLE         I GET_LANGUAGE                  Gets language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTERTITLE         I GET_TITLE                     Gets title                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTERTITLE         I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_CHAPTERTITLE         I SET_TITLE                     Sets title                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_CONTACT              I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_CONTEXTAREA_HANDLER  I HANDLE_REQUEST                handles request                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_CUST_CHECK           I IS_DELETION_ALLOWED           Returns abap_true if deletion is OK                         .
IF_CRM_IC_CUST_SERVICE         I GET_PROFILE                   Returns a specific profile in current language.             .
IF_CRM_IC_CUST_SERVICE         I GET_PROFILE_LD                Returns a specific profile in a specific language.          .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I ADD_DYNCON_PAR                Adds dynamic content parameter                              .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I GET_DYNAMICCONTENTCLASS       Gets dynamic content class                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I GET_ID                        Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I GET_PARAMETERS_LIST           Gets parameters list                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I SET_DYNAMICCONTENTCLASS       Sets dynamic content class                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_DEF          I SET_ID                        Sets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_PAR          I GET_PARAMETERID               Gets parameter id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_PAR          I SET_PARAMETERID               Sets parameter id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_REP          I ADD_DYNCON                    Adds dynamic content                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_DYN_CON_REP          I GET_DYNCON_LIST               Gets dynamic content list                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_EVENT_LISTENER       I HANDLE_EVENT                  handles event                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_EVENT_SRV            I RAISE                         raise event                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_EVENT_SRV            I SUBSCRIBE                     subscribe to event                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_EVENT_SRV            I UNSUBSCRIBE                   unsubscribe to event                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I GET_ID                        Get interaction id                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I GET_LEADING_CONTACT           Get leading contact (if available)                          .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I GET_SOURCE                    Returns source, e.g. call list entry, BP confirm etc.       .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I IS_CONSULT                    True if interaction is result of consult                    .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I IS_NEW                        True if interaction is new (neither transfer nor consult)   .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I IS_TRANSFER                   True if interaction is result of transfer                   .
IF_CRM_IC_INTERACTION          I SET_LEADING_CONTACT           Set leading contact                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_ITEM                 I GET_ITEMTEXT                  Gets item text                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ITEM                 I GET_VALUE                     Gets item value                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_ITEM                 I SET_ITEMTEXT                  Sets item text                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_ITEM                 I SET_VALUE                     Sets item value                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_IVALUE               I GET_CONTENT                   Gets content                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_IVALUE               I GET_SELECTED                  Gets selected                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_IVALUE               I SET_CONTENT                   Sets content                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_IVALUE               I SET_SELECTED                  Sets selected                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_JALERT_SRV           I GET_ALERT_SERVICE             Get instance of alert service                               .
IF_CRM_IC_JALERT_SRV           I INITIALIZE                    initialize alert service                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I GET_LABELID                   Gets label id                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I GET_LABELTEXT                 Gets label text                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I GET_LABELTYPE                 Gets label type                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I SET_LABELID                   Sets label id                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I SET_LABELTEXT                 Sets label text                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_LABEL                I SET_LABELTYPE                 Sets label type                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I CREATE_CHILDREN               Creates the child instances                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I DESELECT_ATTRIBUTE            Remove attribute selection                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns defined attributes                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns source description                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_ID                        Returns source ID                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_MODEL_NAME                Get model name of data source                               .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_PARENT                    Returns null or parent source                               .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_PATH                      Return path from root to attribute                          .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_RELATION_TO_PARENT        Returns name of relation to parent                          .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_TREE_NAME                 Get tree name of data source                                .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I HAS_CHILDREN                  Returns true if source has child sources                    .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I IS_ATTRIBUTE                  Returns TRUE if attribute belongs to source                 .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I SELECT_ATTRIBUTE              Select named attribute                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_LTX_DATA_SOURCE      I SELECT_PATH                   Select source and attribute based on given path             .
IF_CRM_IC_MCM_CALLBACK_HANDLER I EXECUTE                       CallBack Execution                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I ADD_DESCRIPTION               Adds description                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I ADD_RESOURCE                  Add resource                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I ADD_TPARAMETER                Add template parameter                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_ACTION                    Gets action                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_CHAPTERID                 Gets Chapter Id                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_DESCRIPTIONS_LIST         Gets descriptions list                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_ISSCRIPT                  Gets Is Script                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_NODEID                    Gets Node Id                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_NODETYPE                  Gets Node Type                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_OBJECTIONID               Gets Objection Id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_RESOURCES_LIST            Gets ressources list                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_SCRIPTID                  Gets Script Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_SURVEY_URI                Gets survey uri                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_TEMPLATEID                GetsTemplate Id                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I GET_TPARAMETERS_LIST          Gets parameters list                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_ACTION                    Sets action                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_CHAPTERID                 Sets Chapter Id                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_ISSCRIPT                  Sets Is Script                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_NODEID                    Sets Node Id                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_NODETYPE                  Sets Node Type                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_OBJECTIONID               Sets Objection Id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_SCRIPTID                  Sets Script Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_NODE                 I SET_TEMPLATEID                Sets Template Id                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_NODEDESCRIPTION      I GET_LANGUAGE                  Gets language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_NODEDESCRIPTION      I GET_TEXT                      Gets text                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_NODEDESCRIPTION      I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_NODEDESCRIPTION      I SET_TEXT                      Sets text                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I GET_OBJECTIONID               Gets objection id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I GET_OBJ_DESC                  Gets objection description                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I GET_STARTNODEID               Gets start node id                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I SET_OBJECTIONID               Sets objection id                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I SET_OBJ_DESC                  Sets objection description                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_OBJECTION            I SET_STARTNODEID               Sets start node id                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_PARAMETER            I GET_KEY                       Gets key                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_PARAMETER            I GET_VALUE                     Gets value                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_PARAMETER            I SET_KEY                       Sets key                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_PARAMETER            I SET_VALUE                     Sets value                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_PROFILE              I CHECK                         Executes profile check                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_PROFILE              I GET_LOG                       Returns log entries                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I ADD_ANSWER                    Adds an answer                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I GET_ANSWERS_LIST              Gets answers list                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I GET_QUESTIONID                Gets question id                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I GET_QUESTION_TEXT             Gets Question text                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I SET_QUESTIONID                Sets question id                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_QUESTION             I SET_QUESTION_TEXT             Sets Question Text                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_RESOURCE             I GET_NAME                      Gets name                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_RESOURCE             I GET_URI                       Gets uri                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_RESOURCE             I SET_NAME                      Sets name                                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_RESOURCE             I SET_URI                       Sets uri                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I ADD_CHAPTER                   Add script chapter                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I ADD_LINK                      Add script link                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I ADD_NODE                      Add script node to the list of nodes                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I ADD_OBJECTION                 Add script objection                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_AUTHOREMAIL               Gets email of the author                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_CHAPTERS_LIST             Get chapters list                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_DYNAMIC_LINKS_LIST        Gets dynamic links                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_FIRST_LINK_FROM_NODE_ID   Gets first link object for node id                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_INACTIVE                  Gets inactive flag                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_LINKS_LIST                Get links list                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_LINK_FROM_ID              Gets Link object for link id                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_LINK_FROM_LABEL_ID        Gets Link object for label id                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_NEXT_NODE_ID              Gets next node                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_NODES_LIST                Gets nodes list                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_NODE_FROM_ID              Gets Node object for node id.                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_OBJECTIONS_LIST           Get objections list                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_SCRIPTID                  Gets Script Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I GET_STARTNODE                 Gets Start Node                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I SET_AUTHOREMAIL               Sets email of the author                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I SET_INACTIVE                  Sets inactive flag                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I SET_SCRIPTID                  Sets Script Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT               I SET_STARTNODE                 Sets Start Node                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_ACTION        I EXECUTE                       Executes action                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_ACT_HANDLER   I EXECUTE                       Generic calls from Interactive Scripting actions            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTEXT       I ADD_CONTEXT                   Add content to the context                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I GET_CHAPTERS_LIST             Gets objections                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I GET_CHAPTER_ITEMS             Gets nodes assigned to a chapter                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I GET_OBJECTIONS_LIST           Gets objections                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I GET_SCRIPT                    Gets Script                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I GET_SURVEY                    Gets Survey                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I INIT                          Initialize controller                                       .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER    I SET_SCRIPT                    Sets Script                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_DYNCON        I GET_DYNAMIC_CONTENT           Gets dynamic content                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_EVENT         I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_NODE_PRO      I PROCESS_NODE                  Process node                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PBA           I PAN                           Process after node                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PBA           I PBN                           Process before node                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PRO           I SET_PROCESSOR                 Process node                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I BUILD_ID                      Builds id for ui controls                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I FOLLOW_LINK                   Follow script link                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_ACTION_RETURN_VALUE       Gets value from action return                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_BDC                       Gets bdc                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_BOUNDTO_VALUE             Gets bound value                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_LANGUAGE          Get Script Language                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_NODE              Get Current Node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_NODE_ID           Get Current Node Id                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_SCRIPT            Get Current Script                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_SCRIPT_ID         Get Current Script Id                                       .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_CURRENT_SURVEY            Get Current Survey                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_FIELD_VALUE               Gets field value                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_FORM_FIELDS               Gets form fields                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_FORM_VALUE                Gets form value                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_LABEL_TEXT                Gets label text                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_NAVIGATIONAL_LINK         Gets navigational link for curent template                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_PREFERRED_LANGUAGE        Gets preferred language                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_PROCESSOR_CC              Get processor custom controller                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_SCRIPT                    Get Script                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_SCRIPT_CONTROLLER         Gets Script Controller                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_SURVEY                    Get Survey from Repository                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GET_UNBOUND_VALUE             Gets unbound value                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_CURRENT_NODE               Go current node                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_NEXT_NAVIGATION_TEM        Go next based on navigation template                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_NEXT_NODE                  Go next node                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_NODE                       Go to a specific node                                       .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_PREVIOUS_NODE              Go previous node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I GO_START_NODE                 Go start node                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I PARSE_TEXT                    Parse text with placeholders                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I SET_FORM_FIELDS               Sets form fields                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I SET_SELECTED_LANGUAGE         Sets selected language                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I SET_SELECTED_SCRIPT           Sets selected language                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I START_SCRIPT                  Start Script                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I STOP_SCRIPT                   Stop Script                                                 .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I TRIGGER_NAVIGATION            Triggers view navigation                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_PROCESSOR     I VALIDATE_SCRIPT               Validate Script                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_WRAP_CLM      I EXECUTE                       execute                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_SCRIPT_WRAP_MKT      I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_SECTION              I ADD_QUESTION                  Add question                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SECTION              I GET_EVENT                     Gets event                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SECTION              I GET_QUESTIONS_LIST            Gets Questions                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SECTION              I SET_EVENT                     Sets event                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SERVICE              I GET_NAME                      Returns the name of the service                             .
IF_CRM_IC_SEVENT               I ADD_BUTTON                    Add button                                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SEVENT               I GET_BUTTONS_LIST              Gets buttons list                                           .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I GET_ISLINKEDTOSURVEY          Gets linked to survey flag                                  .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I GET_LABELID                   Gets label id                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I GET_LINKID                    Gets link id                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I GET_SOURCENODE                Gets source node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I GET_TARGETNODE                Gets target node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I SET_ISLINKEDTOSURVEY          Sets flag if is linked to survey                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I SET_LABELID                   Sets label id                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I SET_LINKID                    Sets link id                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I SET_SOURCENODE                Sets source node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SLINK                I SET_TARGETNODE                Sets target node                                            .
IF_CRM_IC_SUBMIT               I GET_COMMAND                   Gets command                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SUBMIT               I SET_COMMAND                   Sets command                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I ADD_SECTION                   Adds Section                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I GET_LANGUAGE                  Gets Language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I GET_SECTIONS_LIST             Gets Section                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I GET_SURVEYID                  Gets Survey Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets Language                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SURVEY               I SET_SURVEYID                  Sets Survey Id                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I CLONE                         Creates clone                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I HAS_CHANGED                   Returns true if properties have been changed                .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I LOCK                          Lock profile                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I SAVE                          Save profile                                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I SET_EXTERNAL_SERVERS          Set list of external servers                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I SET_PROPERTY                  Set property by name                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I SET_SERVER_MAPPINGS           Set server mapping                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I TO_STRING                     Convert properties into string                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_DESIGNTIME  I UNLOCK                        Unlock profile                                              .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_RUNTIME     I GET_EXTERNAL_SERVERS          Get list of external servers                                .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_RUNTIME     I GET_PROPERTY                  Get property by name                                        .
IF_CRM_IC_SYSPROPS_RUNTIME     I GET_SERVER_MAPPINGS           Get server mapping                                          .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE             I COPY_2_OF_GET_ID              Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE             I GET_ABAPCLASS                 Gets ABAP class handler name                                .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE             I GET_ID                        Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I ADD_TEMPLATE_PAR              Adds templates parameters                                   .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I GET_ABAPCLASS                 Gets ABAP class handler name                                .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I GET_ID                        Gets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I GET_NAVIGATIONALLINK          Gets navigational link                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I GET_PARAMETERS_LIST           Gets parameters                                             .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I SET_ID                        Sets id                                                     .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I SET_IMPLCLASS                 Sets ABAP class handler name                                .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_DEF         I SET_NAVIGATIONALLINK          Sets navigational link                                      .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_PAR_DEF     I GET_KEY                       Gets key                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_PAR_DEF     I SET_KEY                       Sets key                                                    .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_REP         I ADD_TEMPLATE_DEF              Adds template                                               .
IF_CRM_IC_TEMPLATE_REP         I GET_TEMPLATES_LIST            Gets templates list                                         .
IF_CRM_IC_XML_SPECIAL_TP       I OBJECT_CHECK                  Check if transport is possbile                              .
IF_CRM_IC_XML_SPECIAL_TP       I OBJECT_INSERT                 Insert object into transport request                        .
IF_CRM_IC_XML_TRANSFORM        I UPDATE_FORMAT                 Update XML format to latest version                         .
IF_CRM_LOG                     I GET_LOG_KEY                   Determine Log Key                                           .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL             I CLOSE                         close channel                                               .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL             I OPEN                          open channel                                                .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL_CONTAINER   I CLOSE                         close container                                             .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL_CONTAINER   I GET_ADDRESS                   get address                                                 .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL_CONTAINER   I GET_ID                        get container id                                            .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL_CONTAINER   I GET_TYPE                      get container type                                          .
IF_CRM_MCM_CHANNEL_CONTAINER   I OPEN                          open container                                              .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I ACCEPT                        accept contact                                              .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I FORWARD                       forward contact                                             .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I GET_IAD                       get item attached data                                      .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I GET_ID                        get contact id                                              .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I ON_DELETED                    delete contact                                              .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I POST_PROCESS_STATUS           post processing status                                      .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I PRE_PROCESS_STATUS            pre processing status                                       .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I REROUTE                       reroute contact                                             .
IF_CRM_MCM_CONTACT             I SET_IAD                       set item attached data                                      .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I ADD_CONTACT                   add contact                                                 .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I GET_BCB_SESSION               get corresponding BCB session                               .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I GET_CONTACT                   get a specific contact                                      .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I GET_CONTACTS                  get all contacts of agent                                   .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I LOGOFF                        agent logoff                                                .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I LOGON                         agent logon                                                 .
IF_CRM_MCM_SESSION             I REMOVE_CONTACT                remove contact                                              .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_CHECKER          I CHECK_OBJECTS                 Check Objects                                               .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_CHECKER          I TEST_REQUIREMENTS             Have the prerequisites been met for meaningful use?         .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_COLLECTOR        I COLLECT_OBJECTS               Determine Objects to Be Checked                             .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_COLLECTOR        I POSSIBLE_SELECTION_METHODS    Possible Selection Methods                                  .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_COLLECTOR_DIA    I COLLECT_OBJECTS               Determine Objects to Be Checked                             .
IF_CRM_OBJECT_NAVIGATOR        I NAVIGATE_WITH_CHECK_RESULT    Navigate to Origin of a Check Message                       .
IF_CRM_SAF_IS_GENIL            I GET_SECURITY_PATTERNS         Get security patterns given a set of inputs                 .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I CLASSIFY                      Execute classification                                      .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I CLUSTER                       Execute clustering                                          .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I CREATE                        Create an index                                             .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I DELETE                        Delete one index                                            .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I DELTA_COMPILE                 Execute delta compilation                                   .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I FILTER                        Filtering text content and attributes                       .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I FULL_COMPILE                  Execute full compilation                                    .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I GET_DETAIL                    Get details of a knowledge entity                           .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I GET_DETAIL_PACKAGE            Get details of a knowledge entity's work package            .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I GET_INDEX_INFO                Get basic index information                                 .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I GET_INDEX_NAME                Get the index name                                          .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I GET_RETURN_ATTRIBUTES         Get attribute names retuned with the search results         .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I IS_ALIVE                      Check if the search engine is alive                         .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I REFINE                        Get recommended features for refinements                    .
IF_CRM_SAF_SE_GENIL            I SEARCH                        Search one or more indexes                                  .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I CHECK_DESIG_ENTRIES           Check If Designer Has Made Changes                          .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I COPY_BLVIEW                   Copy Current View to New View                               .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I DELETE                        Delete Application (Only Contents of C Tables)              .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I DEL_BLUEPRINT                 Delete Blueprint Entry                                      .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I EXIT                          Delete Temporary Work Data from Database                    .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_BLAPPL                    Request Application/Application Set                         .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_BLUEPRINT                 Return Blueprint Entry                                      .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_BLVIEW                    Return View                                                 .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_BSP_EVENT_TXT             Event Text                                                  .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_DESIG_URL                 Determine URL for Calling the Designer                      .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_EVENT_POOL                Tabstrip Event Without Event Set                            .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_EVENT_SET                 Tabstrip Event                                              .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_EXCHANGE_ID               Provide ID for Cross-Mode Communication                     .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_MULTIGRP                  Get Keys and Text for Multigroup                            .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_NEWF4DATA                 Read Additional F4 Help Entries                             .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I GET_SUBODC_BLUEPRINT          Get Blueprint Record for Sub-ODC                            .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I IS_MODIFIED                   Check to See if Data Was Changed                            .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I IS_MULTIGRPE_EVENT_REUSABLE   Check Whether Events in Multigroup Can Be Used Again        .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I LOAD                          Load Data from Database                                     .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_CREATE               Create Multi-ODC                                            .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_EVENT_ADD            Add Event in Multi-ODC                                      .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_EVENT_CHANGE         Change Toolbar, Screen Type and Field Group of Event        .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_EVENT_REMOVE         Remove Event From Multi-ODC                                 .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_EVENT_SEQ_CHANGE     Change Event Sequence of Multi-ODC                          .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I MULTIGRP_EVENT_WIDTH_SET      Set Width of Event in Multi-ODC                             .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I ON_COMMIT                     Call After COMMIT WORK                                      .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SAVE                          Save Data to Database                                       .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SAVE_AS                       Save Data to Database under New Name                        .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SET_BLUEPRINT                 Create/Change Blueprint Entry                               .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SET_BLVIEW                    Set view                                                    .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SET_MULTIGROUP                Change/Create Multigroup                                    .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SET_REGTABGRP                 Change/Create Tab Page Group                                .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I SET_TRREQUEST                 Copy Request Number for Transport                           .
IF_CRM_XBAB_BLUEPRINT          I UNDO                          Undo changes                                                .
IF_CTS_BROWSER_SELECTION       I CREATE_INSTANCE               Get Instance for Browser Parametrization                    .
IF_CTS_BROWSER_SELECTION       I DESTRUCT                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_CTS_BROWSER_SELECTION       I GET_NAME_DEFAULT              Set Default for Name                                        .
IF_CTS_BROWSER_SELECTION       I SHOW_SELECTION                Set Browser Parameterization                                .
IF_CTS_COMPONENT               I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description                                                 .
IF_CTS_COMPONENT               I GET_NAME                      Name                                                        .
IF_CTS_COMPONENT               I RUN                           Start                                                       .
IF_CTS_LOG                     I LOG                           Log Character String                                        .
IF_CTS_LOG                     I LOG_MESSAGE                   Log SAP Message                                             .
IF_CTS_LOG                     I WARN                          Log Character String                                        .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I DESTRUCT                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I DISPLAY_TREE                  Display Requests in Hierarchy                               .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I GET_SELECTION_PARAMETERS      Return Selection Parameters                                 .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I GET_TREE_STATE                Get Tree State                                              .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I REFRESH                       Refresh (with New Selection)                                .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I SAVE_SETTINGS                 Save User Settings                                          .
IF_CTS_REQUEST_TREE            I SELECT_REQUESTS_FROM_DB       Select Requests from Database                               .
IF_CTXMNU_INTERNAL             I SERIALIZE_MENU                Menu Formatting                                             .
IF_CUGEN_MASTERDATA            I CHANGE_FIELD                  Change Field by Reference Characteristic                    .
IF_CUGEN_MASTERDATA            I GET_DATA_FIELD                Determines Master Data Value for Reference Characteristic   .
IF_CUGEN_MASTERDATA            I SET_OBJECT_INFO               Sets Object Information in Trace (Procedure Evaluation)     .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I ADOPT_REG_OF_INST_OBS         Transfer Registration                                       .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I CHANGE_IBASE_ONLY             Change CBase Configuration Data                             .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I CHANGE_INST_CONF              Change Configuration Data of Instance                       .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I CHANGE_VALUES                 Change Characteristic Value Assignment of Existing Instance .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I CREATE_CBASE                  Create New IBase                                            .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I CREATE_INSTANCES              Create New Instances                                        .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I DELETE_CBASE                  Delete IBase                                                .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I DETERMINE_CBASE               Determine CBase from Instance Number                        .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I FIND_LAST_VALIDITY_FOR_INST   Gets Last Validity Period for Instance                      .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I FREE                          Initialize Write Buffer                                     .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I GET_CHANGE_STATUS             Write Buffer Deviates from Read Buffer (Database)           .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I GET_REGIST_MOMENT             Gets Time of Registration                                   .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I READ_CBASE                    Read Configuration                                          .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I READ_CBASE_INSTNO             Reads Instance Numbers for CBase                            .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I READ_CBASE_STRUCTURE          Read Structure Information                                  .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I READ_INSTANCE                 Read Individual Instance of Configuration                   .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I READ_OWNER                    Gets Owner of Instances for Configuration                   .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I REGISTER_INSTANCE_OBS         Register Object for Configuration Instance                  .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I RELABEL_INSTANCE_OBS          Update Existing Registration                                .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I SAVE_AND_FREE                 Save and Initialize Write Buffer                            .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I SET_IND_CHANGE_DOCUM          Activate the Writing of Change Documents                    .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I UNREGISTER_INSTANCE_OBS       Deletes Registration                                        .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I WRITE                         Write Configuration to Write Buffer                         .
IF_CUIB_IBCO                   I WRITE_OWNER                   Writes Owner of Configuration                               .
IF_CUIB_IBCO_API               I CONVERT_INTDB_EXT             Convert Object from Datebase into External Format           .
IF_CUIB_IBCO_API               I GET_AGENT                     Gets Instance of IF_CUIB_IBCO_API                           .
IF_CUIB_IBCO_API               I GET_NEW_IF_OBJECT             Create New Interface Instance                               .
IF_CUIB_IBCO_API               I INITIALIZE                    Initialize All Buffers                                      .
IF_CUIB_IBCO_API               I INITIAL_LOAD                  Fill Buffer (Initial)                                       .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I CHECK_OR_INS_BY_CUOBJ_ID      Check or Create CUOBJ_ID                                    .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I FIND_INSTANCE                 Find CUOBJ_ID                                               .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I FIND_OR_INSERT_INSTANCE       Find or Create CUOBJ_ID                                     .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I FIND_OR_INSERT_PERSIST_ID     Find or Create CUOBJ                                        .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I FIND_PERSIST_ID               Find CUOBJ                                                  .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I GET_AGENT                     Gets Instance to IF_CUIB_IBXI                               .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I INSERT_INSTANCES              Fill Buffer (Initial)                                       .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I MODIFY_LOCAL_BUFFER           Modify Buffer Content                                       .
IF_CUIB_IBXI                   I TRIGGER_DB_UPDATE             Trigger Update                                              .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I EVAL_LITERALS                 Evaluation of Selection Conditions                          .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I EVAL_PROCEDURE                Evaluation of Procedures                                    .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I EVAL_SIMPLE_LITER             Evaluation of Simple Literals                               .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I MAKE_INSTANCE                 Create Instance for Low-Level Configuration                 .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I SET_PARENT                    Definition of Parent Instance                               .
IF_CULL_EVALUATE               I SET_ROOT                      Definition of Root Instance                                 .
IF_CULL_VARI_FUNC_TAB          I CONVERT_TAB_KEY_TO_NAME       Determine Variant Table Name from Internal Number           .
IF_CULL_VARI_FUNC_TAB          I VARIANT_FUNCTION              Variant Function                                            .
IF_CULL_VARI_FUNC_TAB          I VARIANT_TABLE                 Variant Table                                               .
IF_CUSTOMIZABLE_MM             I GET                           Supply Configuration View with Model                        .
IF_CUSTOMIZABLE_MM             I SET                           Return Model to Customizing Object                          .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I DELETE                        Deletes attribute values in the database                    .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I GET                           Reads an attribute value (or display context)               .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I GET_BUNDLE_TYPE               Returns unique ID of this class                             .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I GET_INSTANCE_ID               Returns unique ID of this instance                          .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I GET_MASTER                    Reads master flag of an attribute                           .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I IS_CHANGED                    Is attribute bundle changed                                 .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I LOAD                          Loads attribute values from the database                    .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I READ                          Read attribute values from table                            .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I SAVE                          Saves attribute values in the database                      .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I SET                           Sets an attribute value (or display context)                .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I SET_DEFAULTS                  Resets all attribute values to initial values               .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I SET_MASTER                    Sets master flag of an attribute                            .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I TRANSPORT                     Include all attribute values in a transport request         .
IF_CUSTOMIZING                 I WRITE                         Extends table with all attribute values                     .
IF_CUX_CONV_HEADER_EXT2INT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE                                                         .
IF_CUX_CONV_HEADER_INT2EXT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE                                                         .
IF_CUX_CONV_OBJECT_EXT2INT     I CONV_CUXI                     BAPI Format                                                 .
IF_CUX_CONV_OBJECT_EXT2INT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE Format                                                  .
IF_CUX_CONV_OBJECT_INT2EXT     I CONV_CUXI                     BAPI Structure                                              .
IF_CUX_CONV_OBJECT_INT2EXT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE Structure                                               .
IF_CUX_CONV_OWNOBS_EXT2INT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE                                                         .
IF_CUX_CONV_OWNOBS_INT2EXT     I CONV_IBCO                     BTE                                                         .
IF_CUX_CONV_PART_OF_EXT2INT    I CONV_CUXI                     BAPI Format                                                 .
IF_CUX_CONV_PART_OF_EXT2INT    I CONV_IBCO                     BTE Format                                                  .
IF_CUX_CONV_PART_OF_INT2EXT    I CONV_CUXI                     BAPI Format                                                 .
IF_CUX_CONV_PART_OF_INT2EXT    I CONV_IBCO                     BTE Format                                                  .
IF_CUX_CONV_VALUATION_EXT2INT  I CONV_IBCO                     BTE (Delta)                                                 .
IF_CUX_CONV_VALUATION_INT2EXT  I CONV_IBCO                     BTE (Delta)                                                 .
IF_CUX_CORRECT_VALIDITY        I CORRECT_TIMESTAMP             Adjust Validity                                             .
IF_CUX_OWNER_HANDLING          I CFG_CHANGED                   Configuration Changed                                       .
IF_CUX_OWNER_HANDLING          I SET_OWNER                     Sets Owner Information                                      .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_CUST         Returns Default Values for General Customer Data            .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_CUST_CC      Returns Defaults for Company Code-Dependent Customer Data   .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_CUST_SALES   Returns Default Values for Sales Area Data                  .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_VEND         Returns Default Values for General Vendor Data              .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_VEND_CC      Returns Defaults for Company Code-Dependent Vendor Data     .
IF_CVI_DEFAULT_VALUES          I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_VEND_PORG    Returns Default Values for Purchasing Organizations         .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I ADD_OBJECT                    Save Object to Database                                     .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I GET_DDIC_TYPE                 Output DDIC type of a subobject                             .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I GET_IGNORE_FIELDS             Output significant non-key fields                           .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I GET_KEY_FIELDS                Output key fields of a table                                .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I GET_TITLE                     Returns Title of Table in Merge Display                     .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I GET_TYPE_OF_SUBOBJECT         Output type of a subobject                                  .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I MODIFY_DISPLAY_FIELDS         Adjusting Fields Shown in Merge Display                     .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I SAVE_OBJECT                   Save Object to Database                                     .
IF_CWB_DWB_OBJECT              I UNPACK_VERSIONABLE_OBJECT     Required for some object types, else empty implementation   .
IF_CWB_EXTERNAL                I GET_CORR_MEASURE_FOR_REQUEST  Gets the corrective measure for a correction request        .
IF_CWB_EXTERNAL                I GET_RFC_DESTINATION           Gets an RFC destination for a given system                  .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I GET_EDITOR                    Read Editor Object                                          .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I GET_EDITOR_STATE              Read Status for Editor: 'X':Opened; ' ': Closed             .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I GET_MESSAGE_DATA              Determine Message Data                                      .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I INIT_COMMENT                  Initialize Note                                             .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I SAVE_COMMENT                  Save Note as Message                                        .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I SET_EDITOR                    Set Editor                                                  .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I SET_EDITOR_STATE              Set Status for Editor: 'X':Opened; ' ': Closed              .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I SET_TEXT                      Set Note                                                    .
IF_CWB_MESSAGE                 I SHOW_HELP_OBJECT              Display F1 Help for Message                                 .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I APPLY_GRID_DOUBLE_CLICK       Executing Double-Click in ALV Grid Control                  .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I APPLY_GRID_HOTSPOT_CLICK      Executing Hot Spot Click in Grid Control                    .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I APPLY_NODE_DOUBLE_CLICK       Executing Double-Click in Tree Control                      .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I CHECK_EXIT_SCREEN             Checks whether a screen can be closed                       .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I CHECK_NEW_DISPLAY             Gives information about a screen change                     .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I CONTAINER_REQUIRED            Container for display is required                           .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I DELETE_ENQUEUE                Cancel Lock for a Node                                      .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I DO_GRID_CUSTOMIZE             Configure ALV Grid                                          .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_ANCESTOR                  Read Presentiment with ID                                   .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_CHILDREN                  Read Child Nodes                                            .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_CONTAINER                 Reads Set Container                                         .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description of Node                                         .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_EXE_MODE                  Determine Runtime Environ.: 'C':Display from Corr. Instruct..
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_GRID_STRUCTURE            Read Structure Elements for ALV Grid                        .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_ID                        Read Node ID                                                .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_PARENT                    Read Parent Node                                            .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_SETTINGS                  Read Node Settings                                          .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_SUBTREE_STRUCTURE         Generating a Substructure for Tree Control                  .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I GET_TREE_STRUCTURE            Generating a Substructure for Tree Control                  .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I NOTIFY_CHANGED                'X': Data has changed                                       .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I NOTIFY_CHANGING               'X': Data change permitted                                  .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets Container for External Controls                        .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SET_ENQUEUE                   Set Lock on a Node                                          .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SET_PARENT                    Sets a Parent in Node                                       .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SET_TREE_HEADER_TEXT          Set Header Texts                                            .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SHOW_EXTERNAL_DATA            Gets Data for Display                                       .
IF_CWB_NODE                    I SHOW_INFO                     Displays General Information                                .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_COCKPITS                  Retrieve list of configured cockpits                        .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_COCKPIT_INIS              Retrieve all cockpit related information to write INI file  .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_FAVORITES                 Retrieve the list of favorites for the specific user        .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_OBN_TARGETS               Returns the complete set of possible OBN targets for roles  .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_ROLES                     Returns all roles that are available for this user          .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_TEXTS                     Retrieve list of all language dependent texts for DAL       .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_THEMES                    Retrieve list of available themes                           .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_THEME_ENTRIES             Retrieve list of all files in one theme                     .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_THEME_FILES               Retrieve content of all files within one theme              .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_THEME_TEXTS               Retrieve list of all language dependent texts for one theme .
IF_DAL_RUNTIME                 I GET_USER_INFOS                Return small set of user information for welcome text       .
IF_DATABLADE_FACTORY_MM        I CREATE_DATABLADE              Generate an Instance                                        .
IF_DATABLADE_FACTORY_MM        I CREATE_DATABLADE_FROM_STREAM  Read and Generate Persistent Instance                       .
IF_DATABLADE_FACTORY_MM        I CREATE_DATABLADE_SETUPCOMMAND Generate a Command Setup Instance for Datablade             .
IF_DATABLADE_FACTORY_MM        I CREATE_DATABLADE_SETUPVIEW    Generate View Instance for Datablade                        .
IF_DATABLADE_FACTORY_MM        I GET_AVAILABLE_DATABLADES      Which Datablades can be Generated                           .
IF_DATABLADE_MM                I GET_CLASS_LABEL               Class Lable (e.g. ABAP Query)                               .
IF_DATABLADE_MM                I GET_HANDLE                    Handle for Control of Display Variants                      .
IF_DATABLADE_MM                I GET_LABEL                     Object Label (e.g. Variant Text)                            .
IF_DATABLADE_MM                I GET_LOG_GROUP                 Logical Group for Control of Display Variant                .
IF_DATABLADE_MM                I HAS_VARIANT                   Query Executed via Variant Other Than Standard Variant      .
IF_DATAPONDEMAND               I ON_REQUEST_DATA               Request to Send new Data                                    .
IF_DATAPROVIDER_MM             I GET_DATA                      Get Data Reference                                          .
IF_DATAPROVIDER_MM             I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Field Catalog                                               .
IF_DATAPROVIDER_MM             I GET_OBJECTTYPE                Get Object Type                                             .
IF_DATAPROVIDER_MM             I GET_STRUCTURE                 Get Structure                                               .
IF_DATAPROVIDER_MM             I SET_DATA                      Write Data Reference                                        .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY      I ON_APPEND                     Append new Line                                             .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY      I ON_INSERT                     Insert new Line into Table                                  .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY      I ON_MODIFY                     Modify an Existing Line                                     .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY      I ON_REFRESH                    Refresh, Delete Entire Content                              .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY      I ON_REMOVE                     Delete a Line                                               .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY2     I ON_APPEND_RANGE               Append an Entire Range                                      .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY2     I ON_DELETE_RANGE               Delete an Entire Range                                      .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY2     I ON_ENSURE_RANGE               Ensure that this Range is Sent to the Receiver              .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY2     I ON_INSERT_RANGE               Insert an entire Range                                      .
IF_DATAPTABLECACHE_MODIFY2     I ON_MOVE_RANGE                 Move an Entire Range                                        .
IF_DATA_FOR_DELETION           I GET_DATA_4_DELETE_IMPORT      Read Data for a Deletion Import                             .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_ACTIVITIES                Determines Activities                                       .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_ACTIVITIES_PER_TASK       Determines Permitted Activities of a Task                   .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_ACTIVITY_BY_KEY           Transfers Activity and Gives Key                            .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_INSTANCE                  Transfers Instance - Singleton Pattern                      .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_TASK_BY_KEY               Transfers Task and Gives Key                                .
IF_DB_IAM                      I GET_TASK_CATEGORY_BY_KEY      Transfers Task Type and Gives Key                           .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I GET_MANAGER                   Determine DCM Manager for Business Object                   .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I IS_COMPLETE_VERSION_ALLOWED   Allows the Business Object Setting Version to Complete      .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I IS_DELETION_ALLOWED           Does the Business Object Allow Deletion of a Version?       .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I IS_NEW_VERSION_ALLOWED        Does the Business Object Allow Generation of a New Version? .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I IS_UNCOMPLETE_VERSION_ALLOWED Does the Business Object Allow Version in Process Again?    .
IF_DCM_ADAPTER                 I SET_CHANGED                   Set Business Object to "Changed"                            .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I CLEAR                         Delete all objects                                          .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I DEL_OBJECT                    Delete an object                                            .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I GET_CHANGES                   Determine changed values                                    .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I GET_PREDECESSOR               Determine object that precedes the specified object         .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Determine object that follows the specified object          .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I GET_VALUE                     Determine value of an object                                .
IF_DC_ACCESS                   I SET_VALUE                     Set a new value, insert an object                           .
IF_DC_ASSIGNMENT_RFW           I ASSIGN_AUTO_BY_MARKED_COLUMNS Transfer Automatically Created Assignments to Initiator     .
IF_DC_ASSIGNMENT_RFW           I ASSIGN_MANUALLY               Transfer Manually Created Assignments to Initiator          .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I CHANGE_DETAILS                Change detail data for a node                               .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Nodes                                                .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I CHECK_LEAVES_BEFORE_FOLDERS   Check If Leaves Precede Folders in Hierarchy Levels         .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I DELETE_EDGE                   Delete Link                                                 .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Node                                                 .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I DETAIL_NODE                   Display Node                                                .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I GET_DETAILS                   Get detail data for a  node                                 .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I INSERT_NODE                   Create Nodes                                                .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I READ_GRAPH                    Get Graph                                                   .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I RELOAD_NODE                   Reload Node Attributes                                      .
IF_DC_GRAPH_RFW                I SAVE                          Store Graph Changes                                         .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I DATASET_DELETE                Delete specified dataset                                    .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I DATASET_RESTORE               Reset to older dataset (UNDO)                               .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I DATASET_STORE                 Save dataset under a name                                   .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I DISTRIBUTE_CHANGES            Distribute data changes to the graphic proxies              .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I FREE                          Unsubscribe any subscribed graphics proxies                 .
IF_DC_MANAGEMENT               I INIT                          Get application ID, set length of history                   .
IF_DC_SUBSCRIPTION             I SUBSCRIBE                     Enter a graphic proxy subscription                          .
IF_DC_SUBSCRIPTION             I UNSUBSCRIBE                   Unsubscribe to a graphic proxy                              .
IF_DD_SQLT_TOOLS               I ACTIVATE                      Activate Table Pool or Table Cluster                        .
IF_DD_SQLT_TOOLS               I CHECK                         Check Table Pool or Table Cluster                           .
IF_DD_SQLT_TOOLS               I GET_STATE                     Return Status of Table Pool or Cluster                      .
IF_DELETE_BCS                  I DELETE                        Deletion of an Instance                                     .
IF_DELETE_BCS                  I MASS_DELETE                   Delete Multiple Entries                                     .
IF_DELIVERY_ADDRESS_MM         I AFTER_DIALOG                  Get Data from Address Screen                                .
IF_DELIVERY_ADDRESS_MM         I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Provide Data for Address Screen                             .
IF_DELIVERY_ADDRESS_MM         I GET_ADDRESS_DETAIL            Display Address Details                                     .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I F1_HELP_REQUEST               Dynamice F1 Help for Specified  Parameters                  .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I F4_VALUE_REQUEST              Display/Select Values for POV Event                         .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_CONFIGURATION             Provides Parameter Configuration for Display                .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_DEREGPROC_INFO            Display General Text for Process                            .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_DESCRIPTION               Provides Text for Parameter Configuration                   .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_PARAMETER_TEXT            Provides Parameter Description (Short, Medium, Long)        .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_VALUE                     Provides Parameter Value in Internal or External Display    .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RO           I GET_VALUES                    Provides All Parameter Values (Internal or External Display).
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I CHECK_CONTEXT                 Global Parameter Check Against Context                      .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I COPY_DEPENDENT_VALUES         Copy Dependent Parameters                                   .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I DEL_VALUE                     Deletes a Parameter (Including Dependent Values)            .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I SET_CONTEXT                   Transfer Context Info (Such As Service Provider Agreement)  .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I SET_DESCRIPTION               Changes Text for Parameter Configuration                    .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I SET_VALUE                     Set Parameter Value, Incl. Consistency Checks and Conversion.
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I UPDATE                        Save Parameter Configuration                                .
IF_DEREGPARAMETER_RW           I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Save                                                .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Provides Process Description                                .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I GET_PARAMETER_CONFIGURATION   Read Conversion Rules for Parameters                        .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I GET_PARAMETER_GROUPID         Read Parameter Group ID                                     .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I GET_PARAMETER_VALUES          Provide Process Parameters (for Agreement)                  .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I GET_RELEVANT_SERVPROVAGREE    Determine Agreements Relevant to the Process                .
IF_DEREGPROCESS                I SET_PARAMETER_CONFIGURATION   Set Conversion Rules for Parameters                         .
IF_DETERMINATION_PPF           I DESTROY_FOR_TTYPE             Deletes Data for the Action Definition                      .
IF_DETERMINATION_PPF           I DETERMINE                     Starts the Determination                                    .
IF_DETERMINATION_PPF           I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers a Determination Instance for an Action Definition  .
IF_DETERMINATION_PPF           I GET_PERSISTENCY_TABLE         Delivers the Table Where the Data Is Persistently Stored    .
IF_DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT_BRF    I DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT          Determines Assigned Functions and Actions                   .
IF_DETERM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_MODEL_CLASS               Delivers the Model Class                                    .
IF_DETERM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_SUBSCR                    Delivers Report ID and Subscreen                            .
IF_DETERM_VIEW_PPF             I PUBLISH                       Sets the Corresponding Model                                .
IF_DET_ASSIGNMENT_BRF_ICL      I DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT          Determines Assigned Functions and Actions                   .
IF_DET_ASSIGNMENT_BRF_ICLE     I DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT          Determines Assigned Functions and Actions                   .
IF_DET_ASSIGNMENT_BRF_TMP_ICL  I DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT          Determines Assigned Functions and Actions                   .
IF_DIFFERENTIABLE_DIF          I IS_EQUAL                      Test for Equality                                           .
IF_DIFFERENTIABLE_DIF          I PRINT                         Output in Report                                            .
IF_DIMSPPB_DEMAND              I GET_DETAIL                    Get Demand Detail                                           .
IF_DIMSPPB_DEMAND              I SET_DEMAND                    Set Demand Attribute                                        .
IF_DIMSPPB_MAINT_OBJECT        I GET_DETAIL                    Get Maintainence Object Detail                              .
IF_DIMSPPB_MAINT_OBJECT        I SET_MAINT_OBJECT              Set Maintainence Object Attribute                           .
IF_DIMSPPB_OBJ_GRAPHDATA       I GET_DETAIL                    Get Object Graphical Data Detail                            .
IF_DIMSPPB_OBJ_GRAPHDATA       I SET_OBJ_GRAPHDATA             Set Object Graphical Data Attribute                         .
IF_DIMSPPB_ORDER               I GET_DETAIL                    Get Order Detail                                            .
IF_DIMSPPB_ORDER               I SET_ORDER                     Set Order Attribute                                         .
IF_DIMSPPB_RESOURCE            I GET_DETAIL                    Get Resource Detail                                         .
IF_DIMSPPB_RESOURCE            I SET_RESOURCE                  Set Resource Attribute                                      .
IF_DIMSPPB_SLOT                I GET_DETAIL                    Get Slot Detail                                             .
IF_DIMSPPB_SLOT                I SET_SLOT                      Set Slot Attribute                                          .
IF_DIMSPPB_TABLE_DATA          I GET_DETAIL                    Get Table Data Detail                                       .
IF_DIMSPPB_TABLE_DATA          I SET_TABLE_DATA                Set Table Data Attribute                                    .
IF_DIMSPPB_WORK_PACKAGE        I GET_DETAIL                    Get Work Package Detail                                     .
IF_DIMSPPB_WORK_PACKAGE        I SET_WORK_PACKAGE              Set Work Package Attribute                                  .
IF_DIP_REFERENCE_CK            I GET_COST_ESTIMATE_DATA        General Data for DIP Call                                   .
IF_DIP_REFERENCE_CK            I GET_DIP_DATA                  Data for Calling Dynamic Item Processor                     .
IF_DIP_REFERENCE_CK            I SET_DIP_DATA                  Data for Calling Dynamic Item Processor                     .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I CREATE_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION   Generates a New Distributor Business Transaction            .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I DISTRIBUTE                    Triggers the Update of the New/Changed Business Transaction .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I REQUEST_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION  Provides a Reference to an Existing Business Transaction    .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I REQUEST_BUSINESS_TRANSACTIONS Supplies References to TRD BTs (Mass Processing)            .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I SAVE                          Saves all the the Distributor's Updated Data                .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I SET_FLG_FUT_MIGR              Sets the Indicator for Migration of Futures                 .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I SET_FLG_VA_INIT               Sets the flag for initialization of parallel valuation areas.
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I SET_VALUATION_AREA            Sets the Initialization Valuation Area                      .
IF_DISTRIBUTOR_TRD             I UNDO                          Undoes all the Distributor's Updates                        .
IF_DLV_CREATE_EXTOUT           I ADDITIONAL_OUTPUT             Populates ExtensionOut After Delivery Creation              .
IF_DLV_CREATE_NOREF_EXTIN      I ADDITIONAL_INPUT              Transfers ExtensionIn Before Delivery Creation              .
IF_DLV_CREATE_SLS_EXTIN        I ADDITIONAL_INPUT              Transfers ExtensionIn Before Delivery Creation              .
IF_DLV_CREATE_STO_EXTIN        I ADDITIONAL_INPUT              Transfers ExtensionIn Before Delivery Creation              .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I CREATE_FM_PROPOSAL            Generates Proposal for Field Mapping                        .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I CREATE_RCONT_PROPOSAL         Generates Proposal for Recipient Container                  .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I CREATE_SCONT_PROPOSAL         Generates Proposal for Sender Container                     .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I GET_RULE_REFS                 Returns all Used Rules                                      .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I GET_USED_RULE_BY_GUID         Returns a Rule                                              .
IF_DMC_CONT_OWNER              I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create Object                                               .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I DEEP_COPY_OBJECT              Copy Object (Root only)                                     .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object                                               .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I FLAT_COPY_OBJECT              Copy Object (Root only)                                     .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I LOAD_BY_GUID                  Loading an Object                                           .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I MODIFY_OBJECT                 Process Object                                              .
IF_DMC_CREMODDELCOPY           I RENAME_OBJECT                 Rename object                                               .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I COPY                          Copier Constructor                                          .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I CREATE                        Returns Newly Created Object                                .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I DEL                           Deletes Master Data                                         .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I GET_RCONTAINER                Returns Recipient Container                                 .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I GET_REPID                     Returns Program for Screen                                  .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I GET_SUBSCREEN_NO              Returns Subscreen for Selection Screen                      .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I INIT_GLOB_TABLES              Initialization of Table Control                             .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I LOAD_BY_GUID                  Returns Object From DB Using Guid                           .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I RCONTAINER_STILL_VALID        Is Recipient Area Still Vaild, or Should it be Maintained?  .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I SAVE                          Saving the Customizing Data                                 .
IF_DMC_DITYPE                  I STORE_GLOB_TABLES             Saving for Table Control                                    .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I COPY                          Copier Constructor                                          .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I CREATE                        Creates a New Object                                        .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I GET_DYNPRO_NO                 Returns Screen for Maintenance Interface                    .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I GET_EXPTYPE                   Returns Type of Outbound Processing                         .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I GET_REPID                     Returns Program for Screen                                  .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I GET_SUBSCREEN_NO              Returns Subscreen for Selection Screen                      .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I LOAD                          Gets Object From Database Using CUID                        .
IF_DMC_EXPORT_DESC             I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_DMC_FILE_LIST_OWNER         I GET_NODE_ID                   Returns the ID for Tree Control Nodes                       .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I COPY                          Copier Constructor                                          .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I CREATE                        Generates a New Object                                      .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I GET_DYNPRO_NO                 Returns Screen Number for Maintenance                       .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I GET_IMPTYPE                   Returns Type of Import Interface                            .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I GET_REPID                     Returns Program for Screen                                  .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I GET_SUBSCREEN_NO              Returns Subscreen for Selection Screen                      .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I LOAD                          Loads an Object Using a GUID                                .
IF_DMC_IMPORT_DESC             I SAVE                          Saving in Database                                          .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I CMD                           OK Code Processing by Object                                .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I GET_CLASS_NAME_TAG            Returns Runtime Type Information                            .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I LOAD_ATTRIBS_FROM_REL         Loads Master Data Attributes from the Structure             .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I NEXT_VERSION                  Returns Next Versioning Number                              .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I PRINT                         Returns Documentation as Internal Table                     .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I RELOAD_FROM_DB                Loads Original Status from Database                         .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I SAVE                          Saves Data and Component Data                               .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I SAVE_ATTRIBS_TO_REL           Transforms Attributes in a Structure                        .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I SET_DATA_NOT_SAVED            Flag: data_not_saved is set                                 .
IF_DMC_POBJECT                 I SET_DATA_SAVED                Flag data_not_saved Will be Reset After Saving              .
IF_DMC_RECEIVER_SPEC           I CREATE                        Creates an Instance                                         .
IF_DMC_RTO_IL_RULES            I GET_RULES                     GET_RULES                                                   .
IF_DMC_RTO_IL_RULES            I PRINT_RULES                   PRINT_RULES                                                 .
IF_DMC_RULE_ASSIGNE            I GET_VISIBILITY_TYPE           Returns Visibility                                          .
IF_DMC_RULE_CALL_ASSIGNE       I GET_CLASS_NAME_TAG            Returns Runtime Type Information                            .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I COPY                          Copier Constructor                                          .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I DEL                           Delete object                                               .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I GET_CODE                      Returns Rule Body (ABAP Coding)                             .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I GET_CODE_TYPE                 Returns Type of Coding (Form Routine, Macro)                .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I GET_METHOD_PROPOSAL           Returns Proposal for Coding                                 .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I GET_PARAMETERS                Returns the Formal Parameter Bar                            .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I GET_PARAM_BY_GUID             Returns Formal Parameters                                   .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I PRINT_HEADER                  Returns Signature                                           .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I PRINT_IMPL                    Returns Implementation Body Text                            .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I SET_CODE                      Sets Coding                                                 .
IF_DMC_RULE_IMPL               I SET_PARAMETERS                Sets the Formal Parameter Bar                               .
IF_DMC_SENDER_SPEC             I COPY                          Copier Constructor                                          .
IF_DMC_SENDER_SPEC             I CREATE                        Creates an Instance                                         .
IF_DMC_SENDER_SPEC             I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_DMC_STRUCT_TREE_PARENT      I GET_CLASS_NAME_TAG            Returns Runtime Type Information                            .
IF_DMC_STRUCT_TREE_PARENT      I GET_NODE_ID                   Returns Node Information for Representation                 .
IF_DMC_TECHFIELDS              I GET_DEFAULTS                  Returns Technical Data on Fields                            .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I GET_EXPANDED_ICON             Returns Icon for Expanded Nodes                             .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I GET_ITEM_CONTENT              Returns Items for Representation in List Tree               .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I GET_ITEM_TEXT                 Returns Item Text                                           .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I GET_NODE_CONTENT              Returns Node Content                                        .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I GET_NORMAL_ICON               Returns Icon for Non-Expanded Representation                .
IF_DMC_TREE_NODE               I IS_NODE_FOLDER                Returns True, if the Node is not an End Node                .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I GET_ALL_NODES                 Returns all Nodes of the Tree + Root                        .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I GET_FOLDER_NODES              Returns all Nodes that Should be Expanded                   .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I GET_SUBNODES_AND_ITEMS        Returns all Nodes of the Tree                               .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I SHOW_TREE                     Displays Tree in Custom Container                           .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I SHOW_TREE_IN_DOCKING          Displays Nodes in Docking Container                         .
IF_DMC_TREE_OWNER              I SHOW_TREE_IN_SPLIT_DOCKING    Displays Nodes in Docking Container as Splitter Container   .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I GET_CHANGES                   Read Changes from Buffer                                    .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I GET_LINKS                     Read Document Links                                         .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Check Existence of Object Type                              .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_TABLE         Get Table for Object Links                                  .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I INIT                          Reset Buffer                                                .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I POST                          Trigger Update                                              .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I REGISTER_OBJECT_TYPE          Log MDF Object Type On                                      .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I SET_LINKS                     Create Document Links                                       .
IF_DML_SERVICE_DMS             I UNREGISTER_OBJECT_TYPE        Log MDF Object Type Off                                     .
IF_DMS_DOCUMENT                I GET_AUTHORITY                 Getting the authorization object                            .
IF_DMS_DOCUMENT                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description                                                 .
IF_DMS_DOCUMENT                I GET_ID                        Getting the GUID of  DIS                                    .
IF_DMS_DOCUMENT                I GET_NAME                      Name                                                        .
IF_DMS_OFFICE_INTEGRATION      I CLOSE_DOCUMENT                Close a document in an office application                   .
IF_DMS_OFFICE_INTEGRATION      I DESTROY                       Destruction of the objects for the office integration       .
IF_DMS_OFFICE_INTEGRATION      I INIT                          Initialazation of objects for office integration            .
IF_DMS_OFFICE_INTEGRATION      I OPEN_DOCUMENT                 Open a document in the office application                   .
IF_DMS_OFFICE_INTEGRATION      I UPDATE_APPLICATION            Update data in the office application                       .
IF_DM_ACCESS                   I CHECK_ACCESS                  Check Access Authorization                                  .
IF_DM_ACCESS_CONTROL           I GET_ACL                       Gets ACL of Resource                                        .
IF_DM_ACCESS_CONTROL           I GET_SUPPORTED_PRIVILEGES      Gets List of Supported Privileges                           .
IF_DM_ACCESS_CONTROL           I SET_ACL                       Sets ACL of Resource                                        .
IF_DM_ACL                      I GET_PRINCIPALS                Gets Principals Known in ACL                                .
IF_DM_ACL                      I GET_PRIVILEGE_SET             Gets Granted and Denied Privileges of Principals            .
IF_DM_ACL                      I SET_PRIVILEGE_SET             Gets Granted and Denied Privileges of Principals            .
IF_DM_COMPONENT                I CREATE                        Creates New Component                                       .
IF_DM_COMPONENT                I GET                           Gets Specific Component                                     .
IF_DM_COMPONENT                I GET_COMP_NUM                  Gets Number of Component (If It Exists)                     .
IF_DM_COMPONENT                I GET_LIST                      Gets List of Existing Components                            .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I CHECK_REPOSITORY_PROPERTY     Checks Repository Property                                  .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I COPY                          Creates Copy of Document                                    .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I DELETE                        Deletes Document                                            .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I GET_ID                        Gets Document ID                                            .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I GET_INTERFACE                 Gets Interface for Document                                 .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I GET_REPOSITORY                Gets Reference to Repository for Document                   .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I GET_REPOSITORY_PROPERTY       Gets Property of Repository                                 .
IF_DM_DOCUMENT                 I IS_WRITABLE                   Document Modifiable?                                        .
IF_DM_LOCK                     I LOCK                          Creates Lock for Resource                                   .
IF_DM_LOCK                     I UNLOCK                        Release Lock                                                .
IF_DM_PRINT_JOB                I ADD_DOCUMENT                  Add Document to Print Job                                   .
IF_DM_PRINT_JOB                I EXECUTE                       Print the Job                                               .
IF_DM_PRINT_JOB                I IS_DOCUMENT_SUPPORTED         Check if a document is supported                            .
IF_DM_PRINT_JOB_FACTORY        I CREATE_PRINT_JOB              Create Print Job with Specified Parameters                  .
IF_DM_PRIVILEGE                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Privilege Description                                  .
IF_DM_PRIVILEGE                I GET_IDENTIFIER                Gets Technical ID of Privilege                              .
IF_DM_PRIVILEGE                I GET_SUB_PRIVILEGES            Gets List of Aggregated Privileges - Included Here          .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I CLEAR_CACHE                   Delete Cache for Property Values                            .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Deletes All Value Variants of Specified Properties          .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I GET_PROPERTIES                Gets List of Properties of Document                         .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I GET_PROPERTY                  Get an Attribute                                            .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I GET_PROPERTY_DEFINITIONS      Gets Definitions of All Possible Properties                 .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets Properties                                             .
IF_DM_PROPERTIES               I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Property                                               .
IF_DM_PROPERTY_DEF             I GET_DEF_BOOL_PROPERTY         Gets Boolean Meta-Property                                  .
IF_DM_PROPERTY_DEF             I GET_DEF_INT_PROPERTY          Gets Integer Meta-Property                                  .
IF_DM_PROPERTY_DEF             I GET_DEF_PROPERTY              Gets Meta-Property of Property                              .
IF_DM_PROPERTY_DEF             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Description of Property                                .
IF_DM_PROPERTY_DEF             I GET_IDENTIFIER                Gets (Technical) ID of Property                             .
IF_DM_QUERY                    I EXECUTE                       Search                                                      .
IF_DM_READ_CONTENT             I GET_ENCODING                  Gets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_READ_CONTENT             I GET_MIME_TYPE                 Gets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DM_READ_CONTENT             I GET_SIZE                      Gets Size of Document Content                               .
IF_DM_READ_CONTENT             I READ                          Gets Content                                                .
IF_DM_READ_FILE                I DOWNLOAD                      Generate File with Document Content                         .
IF_DM_READ_FILE                I GET_ENCODING                  Gets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_READ_FILE                I GET_MIME_TYPE                 Gets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DM_READ_FILE                I GET_SIZE                      Gets Size of Document Content                               .
IF_DM_READ_URL                 I GET_ENCODING                  Gets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_READ_URL                 I GET_MIME_TYPE                 Gets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DM_READ_URL                 I GET_READ_URL                  Gets URL for Read                                           .
IF_DM_READ_URL                 I GET_SIZE                      Gets Size of Content                                        .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I CONNECT                       Connects to Repository Implementation                       .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I CONNECT_CLASS_ROLE            Gets Implementation of Class Role                           .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Creates New Document                                        .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I GET_NEW_DOC_ID                Creates New Document ID                                     .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I GET_PROPERTY_DEFINITIONS      Gets Definitions for Properties                             .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I GET_REPOSITORY                Gets Repository Object                                      .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I GET_REPOSITORY_PROPERTY       Gets Property of Repository                                 .
IF_DM_REP_IMPL                 I SET_REPOSITORY_PARAMETER      Sets Parameters for Repository                              .
IF_DM_UNBOUND                  I CONNECT                       Connect to Object                                           .
IF_DM_VARIANT                  I CREATE                        Creates New Variant (Not Required for First Variant)        .
IF_DM_VARIANT                  I GET                           Gets Specified Variant                                      .
IF_DM_VARIANT                  I GET_LIST                      Gets List of Existing Variants                              .
IF_DM_VERSION                  I CHECKIN                       Check In Working Version                                    .
IF_DM_VERSION                  I CHECKOUT                      Check Out Version                                           .
IF_DM_VERSION                  I GET                           Gets Specific Version                                       .
IF_DM_VERSION                  I GET_ACTUAL_VERSION            Preparation of the Current Version                          .
IF_DM_VERSION                  I GET_LIST                      Gets List of Checked In Versions                            .
IF_DM_WRITE_CONTENT            I FINISH_WRITE                  End Write                                                   .
IF_DM_WRITE_CONTENT            I IS_WRITABLE                   Can content be created for current user?                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_CONTENT            I SET_ENCODING                  Sets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_CONTENT            I SET_MIME_TYPE                 Sets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DM_WRITE_CONTENT            I WRITE                         Writes Document Content                                     .
IF_DM_WRITE_FILE               I FINISH_WRITE                  End Write                                                   .
IF_DM_WRITE_FILE               I IS_WRITABLE                   Can content be created for current user?                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_FILE               I SET_ENCODING                  Sets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_FILE               I SET_MIME_TYPE                 Sets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DM_WRITE_FILE               I UPLOAD                        Upload File Content                                         .
IF_DM_WRITE_URL                I FINISH_WRITE                  End Write                                                   .
IF_DM_WRITE_URL                I GET_WRITE_URL                 Gets URL                                                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_URL                I IS_WRITABLE                   Can content be created for current user?                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_URL                I SET_ENCODING                  Sets Encoding of Content                                    .
IF_DM_WRITE_URL                I SET_MIME_TYPE                 Sets MIME Type of Content                                   .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I AS_MIME_DOCUMENT              Gets Document in MIME Format                                .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_BODY_PART_ATTRIBUTES      Gets Attributes for a Specific Part of Document             .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_BODY_PART_CONTENT         Gets a Specific Part of Document                            .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_BODY_PART_COUNT           Specifies Number of Parts Document Consists of              .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_IMPORTANCE                Importance of Document                                      .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_SENSITIVITY               Confidentiality of Document                                 .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS                I GET_SUBJECT                   Title of Document                                           .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I GET_DOCUMENT                  Returns a BCS Document Reference if One Exists              .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I GET_GENERICFORM               Returns Form of the Document                                .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I GET_PERSONALIZE               Returns Personalization Type of Document                    .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I GET_PROCESSING                Returns Filter Value for Document Formatting                .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I SET_FORMNAME                  Sets Form Name of Document                                  .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I SET_PERSONALIZE               Sets Personalization Type of Document                       .
IF_DOCUMENT_BCS_PPF            I SET_PROCESSING                Sets Filter Value for Document Formatting                   .
IF_DOCUMENT_DISPLAY_BCS        I DISPLAY_INPLACE               Document Displaye Inplace                                   .
IF_DOCUMENT_DISPLAY_BCS        I DISPLAY_OUTPLACE              Document Display Outplace                                   .
IF_DOCUMENT_DISPLAY_BCS        I INPLACE_IS_SUPPORTED          Checks Whether Document Display Inplace Is Supported        .
IF_DOCUMENT_DISPLAY_BCS        I OUTPLACE_IS_SUPPORTED         Checks Whether Document Display Outplace Is Supported       .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I DELETEPERSISTENT              Deletes the Document                                        .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I GETVALUATIONAREA              Gets the Document's Valuation Area                          .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I INITIALIZEFORPOSTING          Initializes the Document with all Data for Posting          .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I INITIALIZEFORREVERSAL         Initializes the Document for Reversal                       .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I POST                          Posts the Document to Accounting                            .
IF_DOCUMENT_TRAC               I REVERSE                       Reverses the Document in Accounting                         .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I AS_EXTERNAL                   Converts Value to External Format (Output)                  .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I AS_INTERMEDIATE               Converts Value to Intermediate Format                       .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I AS_INTERNAL                   Converts Value to Internal Format                           .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I CHECK                         Checks if Value in Internal Value Is Valid                  .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Information About Domain                               .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I GET_HELPVALUES                Gets Allowed Values                                         .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I GET_TYPE                      Gets Type (Format)                                          .
IF_DOMAIN_POC                  I INIT_DOMAIN_CONTEXT           Initialization of Domain Context (Set Parameters)           .
IF_DRAGDROP                    I ONDRAG                        Call Drag Source                                            .
IF_DRAGDROP                    I ONDROP                        Call Drop Target                                            .
IF_DRAGDROP                    I ONDROPCOMPLETE                Call Drag Source Once Drop Completed Successfully           .
IF_DRAGDROP                    I ONGETFLAVOR                   Returns Flavor of Data                                      .
IF_DRE_LAYOUT_GRID_CALLBACK    I APPLY_LAYOUT                  Use Layout on Vertical Grid                                 .
IF_DRE_LAYOUT_GRID_CALLBACK    I INITIALIZE_GRID               Initialize New Layout                                       .
IF_DROB_RT                     I START                         Starts Data Retrieval                                       .
IF_DROB_RT                     I STOP                           Veto Method !!! DO NOT USE !!!                             .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I ARCHIVE                       Save Signature Data                                         .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I CREATE                        Create Instance for Signature Process                       .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I DELETE                        Delete Signature Data                                       .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I FREE                          Delete Instances                                            .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I GET_BY_ID                     Get Instance for an Existing Signature Process              .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I GET_BY_META                   Get Instance when Entering Meta Data                        .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I GET_DATA_BY_LIST              Signature Data for a List of GUIDs                          .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I GET_REG_INFO                  Get Registration Info for the Applications                  .
IF_DS_RUNTIME                  I REFRESH_BY_LIST               Refresh Data for a List of GUIDs                            .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I CHECK_COMMENT                 Check Comment on Digital Signature                          .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_DEFAULT_REMARK_ID         Read Proposal Remark for Signature                          .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_DOCUMENT                  Get Document                                                .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_METHOD                    Read Short Text For Signature Method                        .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_REASON                    Read Reason for Signature                                   .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_REMARKS                   Read Comment for Signature                                  .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_SIGNED_STEPS              Read Previously Executed Signatures                         .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_SIGNER                    Read Preassigned Signatory                                  .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I GET_STEPS                     Read Current Signature Step for Signature Strategy          .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_CANCELLED_ALLOWED          Simple Cancelation Allowed                                  .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_COMMENT_REQUIRED           Comment is Required                                         .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_DOCUMENT_DISPLAYED         Document is Displayed on the Signature Dialog Box           .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_REASON_DISPLAYED           Signature Reasons are Displayed                             .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_REMARK_DISPLAYED           Digital Signature Remarks are Displayed                     .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_USER_CHANGEABLE            Field for Signatory is Ready for Input on Sig. Dialog Box   .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I IS_VERIFY_ALLOWED             Checks if Verification is Necessary                         .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_COMMAND                   Copy Command from the Screen                                .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_COMMENT                   Copy Comment for Digital Signature                          .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_PASSWORD                  Transfer Password to the Runtime                            .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_REMARK                    Return Selected Remark for Digital Signature                .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_SIGNER                    Transfer Signatory to the Runtime                           .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_SIGN_TIME                 Transfer Signature Time to the Runtime                      .
IF_DS_SCREEN_HANDLER           I SET_STEP                      Selected Signature Step within the Signature Strategy       .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I CHECK_META_OF_INSTANCE        Checks Whether Metadata Match Signature Instance            .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_ID                        Read Signature ID                                           .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_META_BY_ID                Read Meta Data for Signature ID                             .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_STATE                     Determine Signature Status                                  .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_STEPS                     Read Data for Individal Step of Signature Strategy          .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_STEPS_WITH_COMMENT        Returns Saved Data and Comment for Signature Step           .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I GET_STEPS_WITH_DOC            Returns Saved Data/Documents for Signature Step             .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I REFRESH_SIGNATURE             Update Signature Data                                       .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I SAVE                          Save Signature Data                                         .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I SIGN                          Execute Digital Signature for a Document                    .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I UNDO                          Reject Signature Data                                       .
IF_DS_SIGN                     I UNLOCK                        Unlock Header Data Record for Signature                     .
IF_DV_AL_NOTE                  I EDIT_NOTE                     Edit Note                                                   .
IF_DV_AL_NOTE                  I HAS_NOTE                      Note exists                                                 .
IF_DV_BYTE_ACCESS              I GET_BYTES                     Read Contents by Bytes                                      .
IF_DV_BYTE_ACCESS              I GET_SIZE                      Read Contents by Bytes                                      .
IF_DV_SERIALIZE                I DESERIALIZE                   Unpack Document                                             .
IF_DV_SERIALIZE                I SERIALIZE                     Pack Document                                               .
IF_EASYDMS_GET_NEW_FILENAME    I RENAME_FILE                   renaming the original                                       .
IF_EBR_CONTEXT_POC             I CLEAR                         Delete Context Data                                         .
IF_EBR_CONTEXT_POC             I PREPARE                       Prepare Status Change to "Archived"                         .
IF_EBR_CONTEXT_POC             I REFRESH                       Update Context Data                                         .
IF_EBR_CONTEXT_POC             I RESET                         Terminate Status Change                                     .
IF_EBR_CONTEXT_POC             I UPDATE                        Write Status Change to Update Task                          .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_DATA_DEV_ITEM             Get Single Entry for Exceeding Reference Value              .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_DATA_DEV_LIST             Get Deviation List for Exceeding Reference Value            .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_DATA_DEV_SIGN             Get Signature for Entry for Exceeding Reference Value       .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_NUM_DATA_DEV              Get Number of Exceeding Reference Values                    .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_NUM_STEP_COM              Get Number of Comments                                      .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_NUM_STEP_DEV              Get Number of Deviations for Process Step                   .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_STEP_COM_ITEM             Get Comment from Comment List                               .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_STEP_COM_LIST             Get Comment List for Element                                .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_STEP_DEV_ITEM             Get Deviations for Process Step                             .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I GET_STEP_DEV_SIGN             Get Signature for Deviation at Process Step                 .
IF_EBR_DEVIATIONS_POC          I IS_COMMENT_CONTAINED          Is Comment Message Contained in this Document?              .
IF_EBR_FILES_POC               I GET_DEPENDENT_FILE            Get Dependent File                                          .
IF_EBR_FILES_POC               I GET_MAIN_FILE                 Get File for Display                                        .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I COMPUTE_POUNDS_FROM_KG        Compute pounds from kg                                      .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I GET_KIND                      Return kind of entity                                       .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I GET_NAME                      Return weight of entity                                     .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I GET_WEIGHT_KG                 Return weight of entity in kg                               .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I GET_WEIGHT_PD                 Return weight of entity in pounds                           .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SAY_SOMETHING                 Ask entity to make noise                                    .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SET_NAME                      Change name of entity                                       .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SET_PAR_VALS_TAB              Set Tabular Attribute                                       .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SET_PAR_VALS_TAB_STATIC       Set Tabular Attribute - Static                              .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SET_SAYING                    Change favorite noise of entity                             .
IF_ECATT_GD_ENTITY             I SET_WEIGHT                    Change weight of entity                                     .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I ADD_AVAILABLE_REDLINE_LAYER   Declares Available Layer for an Original                    .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I CHECK_IF_LAYER_IS_DIRTY       Checks Whether a Layer is Unsaved                           .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I CREATE_NEW_LAYER              Creates a New Layer                                         .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_ACTIVE_LAYER              Returns Name, Index, etc. of Active Layer                   .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_AVAILABLE_LAYER           Provides Information on an Available Markup File            .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_DIRTY_LAYERS              Passes a List of Unsaved Layers to the Event Handler        .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_LAYER_INDEX               Returns the Index of a Particular Layer                     .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_LAYER_NAME                Returns the Name of a Layer                                 .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_LAYER_VISIBLE             Determine Visibility of Layer                               .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I GET_NUMBER_OF_LAYERS          Returns the Number of Layers                                .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I LOAD_LAYER                    Loads a Redlining Layer                                     .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I REMOVE_LAYER                  Deletes a Particular Layer                                  .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SAVE_ACTIVE_LAYER             Saves the Active Layer in a Local File                      .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SAVE_DIRTY_LAYERS             Informs About Unsaved Layers and Saves Them if Required     .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SAVE_LAYER                    Saves a Layer to a File                                     .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SET_ACTIVE_LAYER              Sets the Active Layer                                       .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SET_LAYER_NAME                Sets the Name of a Layer                                    .
IF_ECL_LAYER                   I SET_LAYER_VISIBLE             Set Layer to Visible / Invisible                            .
IF_ECM_APPLICATION             I CREATE                        Create Object Management Records                            .
IF_ECM_APPLICATION             I DELETE                        Delete Object Management Records                            .
IF_ECM_APPLICATION             I DISPLAY                       Display Object Management Records                           .
IF_ECM_APPLICATION             I GET_MARKED                    Selected Object Management Records                          .
IF_ECM_APPLICATION             I RESET                         Reset Parameters                                            .
IF_ECM_OBJADM                  I OBJADM_ADD                    Create Object Management Records for a Change Number        .
IF_ECM_OBJADM                  I OBJADM_CHANGE                 Adjust Validity of Objects                                  .
IF_ECM_OBJADM                  I OBJADM_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTE       Change the Attributes of Object Management Records          .
IF_ECM_OBJADM                  I OBJADM_DEL                    Delete Object Management Records from a Change Number       .
IF_ECM_OBJADM                  I OBJADM_PROVIDE                Get Object Management Records                               .
IF_EDO_ATOMIC_VALUE            I GET_VALUE                     Read Value in work_area                                     .
IF_EDO_ATOMIC_VALUE            I SET_VALUE                     Copy Value from work_area                                   .
IF_EDO_STRUCTURE               I GET_DESCRIPTOR                Returns Structure Descriptor                                .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I APPEND_EMPTY_LINES            Append Empty Rows                                           .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I APPEND_FROM_WORK_AREA         Append Row from Work Area IF_EDO_TABLE~WORK_AREA            .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I APPEND_ROW                    Add Row                                                     .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I COPY_FROM_TABLE               Copy ABAP Table to EDO Table                                .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I COPY_TO_EDO_TABLE             Copies Range or Set of Rows to Another EDO Table            .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I COPY_TO_TABLE                 Copy EDO Content to ABAP Table                              .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I DELETE                        Delete Rows                                                 .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I GET_DESCRIPTOR                Structure Description                                       .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I GET_FIELD_COUNT               Number of Fields per Row                                    .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I GET_FIELD_VALUE               Read Field in Table                                         .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I GET_RECORD_COUNT              Number of Rows                                              .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I GET_ROW                       Read Row                                                    .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I INSERT_EMPTY_LINES            Insert Empty Rows                                           .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I INSERT_FROM_WORK_AREA         Insert Row from Work Area IF_EDO_TABLE~WORK_AREA            .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I INSERT_ROW                    Insert Row                                                  .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I MODIFY_FROM_EDO_TABLE         Copy Rows from Second EDO Table (Insert/Update)             .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I MODIFY_FROM_WORK_AREA         Change Row Content from Work Area IF_EDO_TABLE~WORK_AREA    .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I MODIFY_ROW                    Change Row Content                                          .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I READ_INTO_WORK_AREA           Read Row in Work Area IF_EDO_TABLE~WORK_AREA                .
IF_EDO_TABLE                   I SET_FIELD_VALUE               Set Field in Table                                          .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I GET_ADJUSTMENT_STATE          Determines Compare Status                                   .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I GET_CONFLICT_TYPE             Determines the Conflict Type                                .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I GET_DATA                      Returns Conflict Data                                       .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I GET_DATA_STRUCTURE            Returns Data Structure Name                                 .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I GET_ID                        Returns Conflict ID                                         .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I SET_ADJUSTMENT_STATE          Sets Adjustment Status                                      .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT            I SET_ID                        Sets Conflict ID                                            .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT_ADJUSTABLE I ADJUST                        Updates the Adjustment Status                               .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT_PROVIDER   I GET_CONFLICTS                 Makes conflicts ready                                       .
IF_EEF_ADJ_CONFLICT_REFRESH    I REFRESH_ADJUSTMENT_STATE      Updates the Adjustment Status                               .
IF_EEF_ADJ_REQUEST             I GET_OPERATION                 Determines operation to be executed                         .
IF_EEF_ADJ_REQUEST             I GET_REQUEST_TYPE              Determines Request                                          .
IF_EEF_ADJ_REQUEST             I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I ADJUST                        Enhancement Adjustment                                      .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I DETERMINE_ADJUSTMENT_STATE    Determines Status of Enhancement Adjustment                 .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I GET_ENHANCEMENT_EDITOR        Determines the enhancement editor                           .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I GET_VIEW                      Returns Tool UI                                             .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I GET_WB_MANAGER                Determines Workbench Manager                                .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I REFRESH                       Refresh                                                     .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I SET_ENHANCEMENT_EDITOR        Sets the enhancement editor                                 .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL                I SET_WB_MANAGER                Sets Workbench Manager                                      .
IF_EEF_ADJ_TOOL_CONFLICT       I REFRESH_CONFLICTS             Updates the conflicts                                       .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW                I DISPLAY                       Display UI                                                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW                I FREE                          Release UI Elements                                         .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW                I IS_IN_EDIT_MODE               Determines Whether View Runs in Change Mode                 .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_GUI_CONTROL    I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_GUI_CONTROL    I SET_CONTAINER_NAME            Set Container Name                                          .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I GET_DYNPRO_NO                 Determines Screen Number of Subscreen                       .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I GET_REPORT_ID                 Determines Report ID (sy-repid) of Subscreen                .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I GET_SUBSCREEN_AREA            Determines Subscreen Area Assigned to View                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I RAISE_USER_COMMAND            Sets a User Command                                         .
IF_EEF_ADJ_VIEW_SUBSCREEN      I SET_SUBSCREEN_AREA            Sets Subscreen Area                                         .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Executes Function of Converter                              .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I GET_MIGRATION_STATE_FLAG      Determines Status of Migration                              .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I IGNORE_MODIFICATION           Ignores Modification                                        .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I MIGRATE_MODIFICATION          Migrates Modification                                       .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I SAVE                          Saves Core Source                                           .
IF_EEF_MIG_CONVERTER           I SET_EDITOR_CORE               Sets Editor of Core Source                                  .
IF_EEF_MIG_MODEL               I GET_OBJECT_STATE              Determines Migration Status of Object                       .
IF_EEF_MIG_MODEL               I SET_OBJECT_STATE              Sets Migration Status of Object                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_MODEL               I UPDATE_ACTIVE_OBJECTS         Updates Active Objects                                      .
IF_EEF_MIG_MODEL               I UPDATE_MIGRATION_STATES       Updates Migration Status                                    .
IF_EEF_MIG_OVERVIEW            I DISPLAY                       Displays View                                               .
IF_EEF_MIG_PERSISTENCE         I GET_MIGRATION_STATE           Determines One Migration Status                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_PERSISTENCE         I GET_MIGRATION_STATES          Determines All Migration Status                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I DISPLAY_OBJECT                Displays Object                                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I FINALIZE                      Terminates Tool                                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I INITILIZE_DATA_CORE           Gets Migration Data from Core                               .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I INITILIZE_DATA_IS             Gets Migration Data of IS                                   .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I MIGRATE_OBJECT                Migrates Object                                             .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I SAVE                          Saves New Object Data                                       .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I SET_MIGRATION_UNIT            Sets Migration Unit                                         .
IF_EEF_MIG_TOOL                I SET_TRKORRS                   Sets Relevant Transport Requests                            .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I INIT_STRUCTURE                Set/Generate/Initialize Work Area                           .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I INSERT_DATA                   Saves Structure from INSERT                                 .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I LOAD_DATA                     Enters Data in Structure                                    .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I LOCK_FOR_EDIT                 Locks Record for EDIT                                       .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I NEW_DATA                      Prepares Structure for new Record (No. Defaults...)         .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I SAVE_DATA                     Saves Structure from EDIT                                   .
IF_EEWA_BO_BASE                I UNLOCK_FOR_EDIT               Removes Lock for EDIT                                       .
IF_EEWA_HW_TRANSPORT           I COPY_FROM_WORKAREA            Copy Data to Local Application                              .
IF_EEWA_HW_TRANSPORT           I COPY_TO_WORKAREA              Copy Local Data in Weighing Order                           .
IF_EEWA_HW_TRANSPORT           I PREPARE_SAVE_DATA             Last Update Before Saving                                   .
IF_EEWA_HW_TRANSPORT           I SAVE_DATA                     Save Without Commit                                         .
IF_EEWA_HW_TRANSPORT           I SET_STATUS                    Sets Current Status                                         .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHANGE_WIZARDSETTINGS         Change Wizard Settings                                      .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHECK_ALL_RFC                 Check Field Definition at End of WIZARD with RFC            .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHECK_FIELDDEF_PAI            Check Field Definition at PAI                               .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHECK_FIELDPOSITION           Checking Positioning of Fields                              .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHECK_FIELDUSAGE              Checking Field Usage                                        .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CHECK_OBJSELECTION            Checking Object Selection in First Screen                   .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CONTROL_FIELDDEF_PBO          Control Behaviour of Field Usage at PBO                     .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CONTROL_FIELDUSAGE_PAI        Control Behavior of Field Usage at PAI                      .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I CONTROL_FIELDUSAGE_PBO        Control Behaviour of Field Usage at PBO                     .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I GET_CUSTOMSCREEN_DATA         Definition of Custom Screen                                 .
IF_EEW_GENWIZ_EXITS            I MAP_CUSTOMSCREEN_TO_HTML      Mapping of Custom Screen Definitions to HTML                .
IF_EFG_SELLIST_ALV             I TOOLBAR                       Modify Toolbar                                              .
IF_EFG_SELLIST_ALV             I USER_COMMAND                  User Action                                                 .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I CLEAR                         Reinitialization                                            .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_ADD_CLASS_DEF             Appl.-Specific Adaption of Characterisics to Be Displayed   .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_ADD_DATA                  Application-Specific Adaption of Data to Be Displayed       .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_ALVLAYOUT                 Determine ALV Layout Structure                              .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_EXCLUDED_TOOLBAR          Determine Pushbuttons to Be Hidden                          .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Gets Instance of the VAI Object                             .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_LAYOUT                    Determine ALV Layout                                        .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_OUTTAB                    Determine 'ALV Outtab' Table                                .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Determine Data for Initializing ALV Grid                    .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I GET_VARIANT                   Affect Layout Behavior                                      .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED      Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_DOUBLE_CLICK               Action on Double-Click                                      .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_DRAG                       Action at Time of Drag                                      .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_DROP                       Action at Time of Drop                                      .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_F1                         Action on Call of F1 Help                                   .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_F4                         Check Routine for Input Help                                .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_INIT                       Actions During Initialization                               .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add Pushbuttons to Toolbar                                  .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I ON_USER_COMMAND               Evaluate User Action                                        .
IF_EHSB_VAI                    I SAVE_TO_DB                    Save                                                        .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I DETAIL_GET                    Read of Planning List                                       .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I FREE                          Release of Memory (Destructor)                              .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I NEIGHBOURS_SET                Handover of References to Neighboring Objects               .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I REFRESH                       Deletion of Data in Display                                 .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I SAVE                          Save All Relevant Values                                    .
IF_EHSH_PCP_DETAIL             I SAVE_PEND_GET                 Read of SAVE-PEND Flag (Unsaved Data Exists)                .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I FREE                          Release of Memory (Destructor)                              .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I HITLIST_GET                   Read of Person List                                         .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I NEIGHBOURS_SET                Handover of References to Neighboring Objects               .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I PERSONS_PUT                   Pass List of Persons to Be Displayed                        .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I REFRESH                       Deletion of Data in Display                                 .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I SAVE                          Save All Relevant Values                                    .
IF_EHSH_PCP_HITLIST            I SAVE_PEND_GET                 Read of SAVE-PEND Flag (Unsaved Data Exists)                .
IF_EHSH_PCP_SELECTION          I FREE                          Release of Memory (Destructor)                              .
IF_EHSH_PCP_SELECTION          I NEIGHBOURS_SET                Handover of References to Neighboring Objects               .
IF_EHSH_PCP_SELECTION          I REFRESH                       Deletion of Data in Display                                 .
IF_EHSH_PCP_SELECTION          I SAVE                          Save All Relevant Values                                    .
IF_EHSH_PCP_SELECTION          I SAVE_PEND_GET                 Read of SAVE-PEND Flag (Unsaved Data Exists)                .
IF_EJB_STUB_CREATE             I CREATE_GLOBAL_TABLE           Creates Global Tables                                       .
IF_EMMA_CASE_FORWARD           I FORWARD                       Forward Case                                                .
IF_EMMA_CWL_LAYOUT             I DETERMINE_SELCRITERIA         Determine Selection Criteria for Case List                  .
IF_EMMA_CWL_LAYOUT             I SELECT_CASES_FROM_DB          Select Cases from Database without REMMACASELIST            .
IF_EMMA_INTINFO_GET            I GET_MASSACT_INTERVAL          Read Interval Information from FI-CA Tables                 .
IF_EMMA_JOB_ANALYZE            I ANALYZE_JOB                   Complete Analysis of Job                                    .
IF_EMMA_KPI_BI                 I WRITE_MSG_TO_BW_DELTA         Update KPI Messages in BW Delta Queue                       .
IF_EMMA_KPI_BI_2               I WRITE_MSG_TO_BW_DELTA         Update KPI Messages in BW Delta Queue                       .
IF_EMMA_KPI_BI_3               I WRITE_MSG_TO_BW_DELTA         Update KPI Messages in BW Delta Queue                       .
IF_EMMA_KPI_BW                 I LAST_CALL_TO_BW_DELTA         No Further Messages Exist for KPI Extract Class             .
IF_EMMA_KPI_BW                 I WRITE_MSG_TO_BW_DELTA         Transfer Messages and Cases to KPI Extract Class            .
IF_EMMA_KPI_MR                 I WRITE_MSG_TO_BW_DELTA         Update KPI Messages in BW Delta Queue                       .
IF_EMMA_LOGMSG_PROCESS         I ANALYZE_MSGS                  Analysis of Messages and Grouping per Business Object       .
IF_EMMA_LOGMSG_PROCESS         I VALIDATE_MSG                  Validation of Message                                       .
IF_EMMA_LOGNUMBER_GET          I GET_LOGNUMBER                 Get Log Numbers                                             .
IF_ENH_AFTER_IMPORT            I AFTER_IMPORT                  After Import                                                .
IF_ENH_COMPOSITE               I GET_LONGTEXT_ID               Read ID of Long Text                                        .
IF_ENH_COMPOSITE               I GET_SHORTTEXT_ID              ID of Short Text                                            .
IF_ENH_COMPOSITE               I SET_LONGTEXT_ID               Set Long Text ID                                            .
IF_ENH_COMP_CWB                I CONVERT_DATA_FROM_CWB         Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_COMP_CWB                I CONVERT_DATA_TO_CWB           Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_COMP_CWB                I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_COMP_CWB                I DELETE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_COMP_CWB                I GET_DATA                      Get Data for TOOL                                           .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I ADD_HOOK_DEF                  Add Hook Definition                                         .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I DELETE_HOOK_DEF               Delete Hook Definition                                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I GET_ALL_HOOK_DEFS             Reads all hook impl. of all enh. obj. for the framew. prog. .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I GET_FULL_NAME_FOR_HOOK_NAME   Create FULL_NAME from Hook Name                             .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I GET_HOOK_NAME_FROM_FULL_NAME  Read Hook Name from FULL_NAME                               .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I IS_EXISTING                   Does Hook ID Already Exist?                                 .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I LOCK_ENH_SPOTS_FOR_INCLUDE    Locks Enhancement Spots on Basis of Includes                .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I MORE_THAN_ONE_SPOT            Hook Contained in Several Spots; Warning!                   .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION_DEF   Reset to Active Version                                     .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I SELECT_ENHANCEMENT_SPOT       Dialog for Selecting an Enhancement Spot                    .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I SET_ATTRIBUTES_FOR_SPOTS      Set Transport/Package                                       .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_DEFS     I UNLOCK_ALL_ENHANCEMENT_SPOTS  Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I ADD_HOOK_IMPL                 Add Hook Implementation                                     .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I CHANGE_HOOK_IMPL              Change Hook Implementation                                  .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I DELETE_HOOK_IMPL              delete Hook Implementation                                  .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_ACTUAL_ENHNAME            Current Enhancement (Single Enh. Mode)                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_ALL_HOOK_IMPLS            Reads all hook impl. of all enh. obj. for the framew. prog. .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_CONTAINER_4_ENHANCEMENT   Read Container for Nested Enhancements                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_DELETED_ENHS_4_ABAP       Generation of Deleted Enhancements for ABAP Compiler        .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_ENHANCEMENTS_4_HOOK       Read Enhancements for Hook                                  .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_ENHANCEMENT_LINE_4_ABAP   Generate Line for ABAP Compiler                             .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_ENH_POS                   For Navigation                                              .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_EXTID_FOR_FULL_NAME       For Navigation                                              .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_INCLUDE_POS               For Navigation                                              .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_NOT_LOCKED_ENHANCEMENTS   For Navigation                                              .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_PREFERED_ENHANCEMENTS     Returns enhancments from current business set               .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I GET_SUB_ENHANCEMENT_NAMES     Reads All Subenhancements                                   .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I LOCK_ENHANCEMENTS_FOR_INCLUDE Locks Enhancements on Include Basis                         .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I LOCK_ENHANCEMENT_FOR_INCLUDE  Locks Enhancements on Include Basis                         .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION_IMPL  Return to Active Version                                    .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SELECT_ENHANCEMENT            Dialog Box for Enhancement Selection                        .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SELECT_SUB_ENHANCEMENT        Dialog Box for Enhancement Selection                        .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SET_ACTUAL_ENHNAME            Set or Delete Current Enhancement Name                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SET_ATTRIBUTES_FOR_ENHS       Set Transport/Package                                       .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SET_HOOK_IMPLS                Reads all hook impl. of all enh. obj. for the framew. prog. .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I SET_HOOK_IMPL_SOURCES         Returns Changed Sources                                     .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I UNLOCK_ALL_ENHANCEMENTS       Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_CONTAINER_HOOK_IMPLS    I UNLOCK_ENHANCEMENT            Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_ATTRIBUTES_DELTA          Determines Difference Between Attributes                    .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_CONTRACT_ATTRIBUTES       Determines Attributes Saved in Contract                     .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_CONTRACT_PARAMETERS       Determines Method Parameters Saved in Contract              .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_CURRENT_ATTRIBUTES        Determines Current Attributes of Class                      .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_CURRENT_PARAMETERS        Determines Method Parameters of Class                       .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_CLASS          I GET_PARAMETERS_DELTA          Determines Difference of Method Parameters                  .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_FUGR           I GET_CONTRACT_PARAMETERS       Determines Parameters Saved in Contract                     .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_FUGR           I GET_CURRENT_PARAMETERS        Determines Current Parameters of Function Group             .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_FUGR           I GET_PARAMETER_DELTA           Determines Differences Between Parameters                   .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_CONTRACT_SOURCE           Determines the include source stored in the contract        .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_CURRENT_SOURCE            Determines the include source contained in the system       .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_ENHANCEMENTS_BY_INCLUDE   Determines all enhancements of an include                   .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_INCLUDES                  Determines all include names stored in the contract         .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_INCLUDES_BY_ENHANCEMENT   Determines all include names enahnced by the enhancement    .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_MODULARIZATION_UNIT_SOURCEDetermines the source of a modularization unit              .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_HOOK_IMPL      I GET_SOURCE_DELTA              Determines the delta between the contract and system source .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I BUILD_NEW_CONTRACT_DATA       Build New Contract Data for Adjustment Tool                 .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I CHECK_CONTRACT                Check Contract Data in Upgrade Case                         .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I CORRECT_ENHCROSS_AFTER_IMP    Correct ENHCROSS in Contract Data After Import              .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I GET_CONTRACT_TABLES           Get Contract Tables                                         .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I GET_XSTRING                   Get Contract Data xstring from Instance                     .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I INIT_BY_CONTRACT_DATA         Initialize Contract Data                                    .
IF_ENH_CONTRACT_TOOL           I INIT_BY_OBJECT                Get Contract Information                                    .
IF_ENH_CWB                     I CONVERT_DATA_FROM_CWB         Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_CWB                     I CONVERT_DATA_TO_CWB           Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_CWB                     I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_CWB                     I DELETE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_CWB                     I GET_DATA                      Get Data for TOOL                                           .
IF_ENH_CWB_SPOT                I CONVERT_DATA_FROM_CWB         Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_CWB_SPOT                I CONVERT_DATA_TO_CWB           Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_CWB_SPOT                I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_CWB_SPOT                I DELETE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_CWB_SPOT                I GET_DATA                      Get Data for TOOL                                           .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_ACTIVE_TAB                Determine FCODE of Active TABSTRIPs                         .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_FCODE                     Get Sequence FCODE from PLUGIN                              .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_FCODES                    Get FCODE Table for LOG Processing                          .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_GROUP                     Return Allowed Group                                        .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_STATUS                    Set GUI Status and EXCL Table                               .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I GET_SUB_SCREENS               Get SUBSCREENs for LOG Processing                           .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I SET_FCODE                     Get Sequence FCODE from PLUGIN                              .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I SHOW_LOG_ENTRY                Display LOG Entry                                           .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I WB_GET_REF                    Get Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing            .
IF_ENH_LOG_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN  I WB_SAVE_REF                   Save Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing           .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I ACTIVATE_IN_WORKINGAREA       Activate Using Work-in-Area Dialog                          .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I AFTER_IMPORT                  After Import Method                                         .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I BEFORE_EXPORT                 Before Export Method                                        .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I CHECK_4_DEL_OBJECT            Repair if Dependent Object Is Deleted?                      .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GENERATE                      Generate                                                    .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_DATA                      Reading Data                                                .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_DEVCLASS                  Read Package                                                .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_LANGUAGE                  Read Language                                               .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_SRCSYSTEM                 Read Orginal System                                         .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_TRKORR                    Read Transport Request                                      .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_TYPENAME                  Returns the Data Type                                       .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I GET_VERSNO                    Read Version Number (Version Management)                    .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I HAS_ACTIVE_VERSION            Has Active Version                                          .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I HAS_INACTIVE_VERSION          Has Inactive Version                                        .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I HAS_NOT_SAVED_INACTIVE_VERSIONHas Inactive Version Not Saved Yet                          .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I HAS_SAVED_INACTIVE_VERSION    Has Saved Inactive Version                                  .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I IS_LOCKED                     Object Locked (Changeable)?                                 .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I IS_MODIFIED                   Object Is Modified                                          .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I IS_NEW                        Object Is New (Unsaved)?                                    .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I REPAIR                        Automatic Repair                                            .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I REPAIR_NECESSARY              Repair Required                                             .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION       Return to Active Version                                    .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I SAVE                          Save Enhancement                                            .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I SAVE_FROM_VERSION             Save Enhancement                                            .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I SET_LOCKED                    Set Lock for SCWB Processing                                .
IF_ENH_OBJECT                  I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_OBJECT_DOCU             I DELETE_LONGTEXT               Delete Long Text and Save Object                            .
IF_ENH_OBJECT_DOCU             I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Read Short Text                                             .
IF_ENH_OBJECT_DOCU             I HAS_LONG_TEXT                 Check Whether Long Text Exists                              .
IF_ENH_OBJECT_DOCU             I OPEN_LONGTEXT_EDITOR          Long Text Editor Dialog (Create it and Save Obj. if Necess.).
IF_ENH_OBJECT_DOCU             I SET_SHORTTEXT                 Change Short Text                                           .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_DEFAULT_TAB               Return DEFAULT Tab                                          .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_FCODES                    Return Allowed FCODEs                                       .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_GROUP                     Get Group                                                   .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_GUI_STATUS                Determine GUI Status                                        .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_MAIN_SCREEN_NR            Get Main Screen Number                                      .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_NAME_OF_ENH_TYPE          Get Type Specification of Processed Object                  .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_SUB_SCREENS               Get SUBSCREENS                                              .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Set                                                         .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I GET_UPGRADE_TAB               Return TAB for UPGRADE Tool                                 .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I SET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Set                                                         .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I WB_GET_REF                    Get Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing            .
IF_ENH_PLUGIN                  I WB_SAVE_REF                   Save Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing           .
IF_ENH_SPOTCOMP_CWB            I CONVERT_DATA_FROM_CWB         Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_SPOTCOMP_CWB            I CONVERT_DATA_TO_CWB           Convert TOOL Data to CWB Data                               .
IF_ENH_SPOTCOMP_CWB            I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOTCOMP_CWB            I DELETE_OBJECT                 Create an Enh. Object                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOTCOMP_CWB            I GET_DATA                      Get Data for TOOL                                           .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMPOSITE          I GET_LONGTEXT_ID               Read ID of Long Text                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMPOSITE          I GET_SHORTTEXT_ID              Read ID of Short Text                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMPOSITE          I SET_LONGTEXT_ID               Set Long Text ID                                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMP_PLUGIN        I ADD_AND_REMOVE_BUTTONS        Add and Remove Buttons                                      .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMP_PLUGIN        I GET_GUI_STATUS                GUI Status                                                  .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMP_PLUGIN        I GET_MAIN_SCREEN_NR            Screen Number                                               .
IF_ENH_SPOT_COMP_PLUGIN        I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_DEFAULT_TAB               Set Default Tab                                             .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_FCODES                    Return Allowed FCODEs                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_GROUP                     Get Group                                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_GUI_STATUS                Determine GUI Status                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_MAIN_SCREEN_NR            Get Main Screen Number                                      .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_NAME_OF_ENH_TYPE          Get Type Specification of Processed Object                  .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_SUB_SCREENS               Enhancement Screen Subscreen Table                          .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Set                                                         .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I GET_UPGRADE_TAB               Set UPGRADE Tab                                             .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I SET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Set                                                         .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I WB_GET_REF                    Get Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_PLUGIN             I WB_SAVE_REF                   Save Workbench Reference for SUBSCREEN Processing           .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I ADD_ELEMENT_SAP_OBJECT        Add Element                                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I COPY_DOCU                     Copy Long Text                                              .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I COPY_TEXT                     Copy Text                                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I CREATE_TEXT                   Create Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I DELETE                        Delete Spot                                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I DELETE_DOCU                   Delete Long Text                                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Element                                              .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I DELETE_LONGTEXT               Delete Enhancement Long Text                                .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I ELEMENTS_MODIFIED             Elements Added or Removed                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Read Change Parameter                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_DATA                      Get Enhancement Data                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_DATABUFFER                Internal (for Persistence Layer)                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_DATA_VERSION              Read Enhancement Data Version                               .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_DEVCLASS                  Read Package                                                .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_ELEMENTS                  Read Elements                                               .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_LANGUAGE                  Read Language                                               .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_NAME                      Read Enhancement Name                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Read Enhancment Short Text                                  .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_SRCSYSTEM                 Read Original System                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_TEXT                      Read text                                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_TOOL                      Enhancement Tool                                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I GET_TRKORR                    Read Request                                                .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I HAS_LONG_TEXT                 Check Whether Long Text Exists                              .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I HEADER_MODIFIED               Enhancement Modified                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I IS_LOCKED                     Enhancement Store Locked?                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I IS_NEW                        Enhancement New or Saved                                    .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I IS_SUBOBJECT_LOCKED           Virtual Subobject Locked?                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I OPEN_DOCU_EDITOR              Long Text Editor                                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I OPEN_LONGTEXT_EDITOR          Read Enhancement Long Text                                  .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION       Return to Active Version                                    .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SAVE                          Create Log Entry + Save Enhancement/Elements/Log            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SAVE_FROM_VERSION             Create Log Entry + Save Enhancement/Elements/Log            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SEMA_GET                      Lock Using semaphore                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SEMA_RELEASE                  Delete Semaphore                                            .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SET_DATA                      Set Enhancement Data                                        .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I SET_SHORTTEXT                 Read Enhancement Short Text                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_STORE              I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I COPY_ALLOWED                  Copy Enhancement Allowed?                                   .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I DELETE_ALLOWED                Delete Enhancement Allowed?                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I ENHS_AFTER_IMPORT_DELETE      Delete Inactive/Generated Data after Deletion Transport     .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              Read All Enhancement Elements                               .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_ICON                      Read Icon for SPAU/SE95                                     .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_NAME                      Enhancement Spot Name                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_PLUGIN_UI                 Access to UI Plug-In for Detail Display                     .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_TOOL                      Enhancement Spot Tool                                       .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I GET_TOOL_OBJECT_TEXTS         Supplies SOTR texts contained in object                     .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I IMPLEMENT                     Implement Spot                                              .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I INIT                          Is Called by Framework to Instantiate Class                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I RENAME_ALLOWED                Rename Enhancement Allowed?                                 .
IF_ENH_SPOT_TOOL               I UPDATE_REGISTRY               Object Environment Changed, Update Registry                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ADD_DEPENDENT_ENHANCEMENT     Add Dependency                                              .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ADD_ELEMENT_SAP_OBJECT        Add Element + Create Log Entry                              .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ADD_ELEMENT_SAP_TABU          Add Element + Create Log Entry                              .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ADD_LOG_ENTRY                 Add Log Entry                                               .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I COPY_DOCU                     Copy Long Text                                              .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I COPY_TEXT                     Copy Text                                                   .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I CREATE_TEXT                   Create Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I DELETE_DOCU                   Delete Long Text                                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Element + Create Log Entry                           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I DELETE_LONGTEXT               Read Enhancement Long Text                                  .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Text                                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I DEPENDENT_ENH_MODIFIED        Appended Enhancements Changed                               .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I ELEMENTS_MODIFIED             Elements Added or Removed                                   .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_DATA                      Get Enhancement Data                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_DATABUFFER                Internal (for Persistence Layer)                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_DATA_VERSION              Read Enhancement Data Version                               .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_DEPENDENT_ENHANCEMENTS    Read Dependent Enhancements                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_DEVCLASS                  Read Package                                                .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_ELEMENTS                  Read Elements                                               .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_LANGUAGE                  Read Language                                               .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_LOG_ENTRIES               Get Log Entries                                             .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_NAME                      Read Enhancement Name                                       .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_POSSIBLE_DEPENDENT_ENHS   Determine Possible Dependent Enhancements                   .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Read Enhancment Short Text                                  .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_SRCSYSTEM                 Read Original System                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_STATE                     Read Enhancement Status                                     .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_TEXT                      Read text                                                   .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_TOOL                      Enhancement Tool                                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_TRKORR                    Read Package                                                .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I GET_TYPE                      Read Enhancment Type                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I HAS_LONG_TEXT                 Does Long Text for Version Exist?                           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I HEADER_MODIFIED               Enhancement Modified                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I IS_IN_UPGRADE_MODE            Read Upgrade Flag                                           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I IS_LOCKED                     Enhancement Store Locked?                                   .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I IS_NEW                        Enhancement New or Saved                                    .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I IS_SUBOBJECT_LOCKED           Is Virtual Subobject Locked?                                .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I IS_TO_READ_FROM_DB            Read ENHINCINX from DB or from VERS/LOG/SCWB/NOTE           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I LOG_MODIFIED                  Log Entries Added                                           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I OPEN_DOCU_EDITOR              Long Text Editor                                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I OPEN_LONGTEXT_EDITOR          Read Enhancement Short Text                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I REMOVE_DEPENDENT_ENHANCEMENT  Remove Dependency                                           .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I REREAD                        Read Again                                                  .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I RESET_TO_ACTIVE_VERSION       Return to Active Version                                    .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SAVE                          Create Log Entry + Save Enhancement/Elements/Log            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SAVE_FROM_VERSION             Create Log Entry + Save Enhancement/Elements/Log            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SEMA_GET                      Lock Using semaphore                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SEMA_RELEASE                  Delete Semaphore                                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_DATA                      Set Enhancement Data                                        .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_DATA_4_DELETE_IMPORT      Set Data for a Possible Deletion Import                     .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_DATA_4_DEL_IMPORT_DIRECT  Direct Writing of Data for a Possible Deletion Import       .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_LONGTEXT_ID               Read Enhancement Long Text                                  .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_SHORTTEXT                 Read Enhancement Short Text                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_SHORTTEXT_ID              Read Enhancement Short Text                                 .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_STATE                     Read Enhancement Status                                     .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I SET_UPGRADE_MODE              Set Upgrade Flag                                            .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_ENH_STORE                   I UNSET_UPGRADE_MODE            Upgrade (Adjustment) Terminated                             .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I COMPARE_WITH                  Compares the object with another object                     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I COPY_ALLOWED                  Delete Enhancement Allowed?                                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I DELETE_ALLOWED                Delete Enhancement Allowed?                                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I DETERMINE_ADJUSTMENT_STATE    Determine Adjustment Status                                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I ENHO_AFTER_IMPORT_DELETE      Delete Inactive/Generated Data after Deletion Transport     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_ADJUSTMENT_STATE          Read Adjustment Status                                      .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_ADJUSTMENT_TOOL           Returns Enhancement Adjustment Tool                         .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              Read All Enhancement Elements                               .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_DEPENDENT_ENHANCEMENTS    Returns All Directly Dependent Enhancement Names            .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_DIFFERENCES_PLUGIN        Access to UI Plug-In for Delta Display                      .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_INACTIVE_SUBOBJECTS       Read Corresponding Inactive Subobjects (for ABAP Runtime)   .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_INVOLVED_REQUESTS         Read All Transport Requests Involved                        .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_INVOLVED_USERS            Read All Users Involved                                     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_LOG                       Read Log                                                    .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_NAME                      Unique ID of Enhancement                                    .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_PLUGIN_UI                 Access to UI Plug-In for Detail Display                     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_TOOL                      Read Corresponding Tool Type                                .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_TOOL_OBJECT_TEXTS         Supplies SOTR texts contained in object                     .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I GET_TYPE                      Type of Enhancement                                         .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I INIT                          Is Called by Framework to Instantiate Class                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I IS_IN_UPGRADE_MODE            Adjustment Not Terminated Yet                               .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I RENAME                        Rename                                                      .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I RENAME_ALLOWED                Rename Enhancement Allowed?                                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I RESTORE_FROM_LOG              Retrieve Version from Log                                   .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I SWITCH_STATE_CHANGED          Corresponding Switch Changed                                .
IF_ENH_TOOL                    I UPDATE_REGISTRY               Object Environment Changed, Update Registry                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I GET_MODIFIED_ELEMENTS         Read Modified Objects                                       .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I IS_DELETED                    Modified Object No Longer Exists                            .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I IS_MODIFIED                   Modification Is Active                                      .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I IS_RESETED                    Modification Is Reset                                       .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I NAVIGATE                      Navigation to Editor                                        .
IF_ENH_TOOL_MODIFICATION       I RESET                         Reset Modification                                          .
IF_ENH_TOOL_REDEFINITION       I GET_EXTENDED_ELEMENTS         Read Enhanced Orginal Objects                               .
IF_ENH_TOOL_REDEFINITION       I GET_EXTENTION_ELEMENTS        Read New Enhancement Objects                                .
IF_ENH_TOOL_REDEFINITION       I REMOVE                        Delete Redefinition                                         .
IF_ENH_TOOL_USAGE              I GET_USED_ELEMENTS             Read Used Objects                                           .
IF_ENH_TOOL_USAGE              I GET_USING_ELEMENTS            Read Usages                                                 .
IF_ENH_TOOL_USAGE              I REMOVE                        Delete Redefinition                                         .
IF_ENH_UVL                     I COMPARE_2_TABS                Compare 2 Objects                                           .
IF_ENH_UVL                     I DISPLAY                       Display one entry                                           .
IF_ENH_UVL                     I PREPARE_COMPARE               Prepare Comparison of Two Entries                           .
IF_ENH_UVL                     I RETRIEVE                      Retrieve One Entry                                          .
IF_ENH_UVL_VIS                 I INIT_ALV                      Instantiate ALV-GRID                                        .
IF_ENH_UVL_VIS                 I INIT_CONTROL                  Instantiate GUI Control                                     .
IF_ENH_UVL_VIS                 I INIT_TREE                     Initialize TREE                                             .
IF_ENH_VERS_TREE_COMPARE       I GET_NODE_TYPE                 Returns type of node                                        .
IF_ENH_VERS_TREE_COMPARE       I GET_SOURCE_TABS               Returns properties of a node                                .
IF_ESFSMP_SERVICE_MANAGER      I GET_BO_MOD_CONFIG_NAMES       not implemented                                             .
IF_ESF_ACTION                  I EXECUTE                       Execute action                                              .
IF_ESF_ACTION                  I GET_DESCRIPTOR                Returns Descriptor                                          .
IF_ESF_ACTION                  I GET_INPUT_KEYLIST             Returns List of Keys                                        .
IF_ESF_ACTION                  I GET_INPUT_PARAMETER_STRUCTURE Returns Structure of Input Parameters                       .
IF_ESF_ACTION                  I IS_FAILED                     Set when action was executed incorrectly                    .
IF_ESF_ACTION_DESC             I GET_BO_NODE_DESCRIPTOR        Elternelement der Aktion                                    .
IF_ESF_ACTION_DESC             I GET_CARDINALITY               Eingestellte Kardinalität der Aktion                        .
IF_ESF_ACTION_DESC             I GET_INPUT_PARAM_STRUC_DESC    Input Param Strukturdeskriptor                              .
IF_ESF_ACTION_DESC             I HAS_INPUT_PARAMETERS          hat Input Parameter                                         .
IF_ESF_ATT_PROP_CONTAINER_DESC I GET_ATTRIB_PROP_NAMES         Read All Properties of Attribute                            .
IF_ESF_ATT_PROP_CONTAINER_DESC I GET_ATTRIB_PROP_STRING_VALUE  Returns Property Value as String                            .
IF_ESF_ATT_PROP_CONTAINER_DESC I GET_ATTRIB_PROP_STRING_VALUES Returns Property Value as String                            .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE                 I INVALIDATE                    Vormerkung für Refresh                                      .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE                 I ITERATOR_NEXT                 Liest nächstes Element                                      .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE                 I ITERATOR_START                Iteriert über alle Elemente beginnend bei Index             .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE                 I SIZE                          Liefert Anzahl der BO Knotenelemente                        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_BO_DESCRIPTOR             Deskriptor des übergeordneten BOs                           .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_DATA_STRUCTURE_DESCRIPTOR Returns Data Structure Descriptor                           .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_PARENT_BO_NODE_DESCRIPTOR Instanz des Elternelements                                  .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_QUERY_DESCRIPTOR          Liefert Query Deskriptor                                    .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_QUERY_DESCRIPTORS         Liefert alle Query Deskriptoren des BOs                     .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_QUERY_NAMES               Liefert Namen aller Queries                                 .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_DESC            I GET_STRUCTURE_DESCRIPTOR      Returns Structure Descriptor                                .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I ADD_META_ACTION               Add Action to Button                                        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I ADD_META_ASSOCIATION          Add Assocation to Button                                    .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I ADD_META_COLUMN               Add Column to Control                                       .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I DISPLAY_ADD_LINE              Adds Row to Control                                         .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I DISPLAY_CONTROL               Outputs Grid in Full                                        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I DISPLAY_REFRESH               Refresh Display (After Insert/Delete/...)                   .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I DISPLAY_RESET                 Resets Display                                              .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I FREE                          Deregisters all controls                                    .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I INPUT_FIELDS                  Makes input fields visible/unvisible                        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_VIEW_CTL        I MARK_LINES                    Selects individual lines                                    .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_WDP             I CREATE_HASHED_VALUE_TABLE_TYPECreate Data Type and Table                                  .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_WDP             I DELETE_HASHED_VALUE_TABLE     Delete Multiple BO Nodes with Hash Key (Ref to Data)        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_WDP             I GET_HASHED_VALUE_TABLE        Returns Aspect Content with Hash Key as Whole (Ref to Data) .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_WDP             I INSERT_HASHED_VALUE_TABLE     Insert Multiple BO Nodes with Hash Key (Ref to Data)        .
IF_ESF_BO_NODE_WDP             I UPDATE_HASHED_VALUE_TABLE     Change Multiple BO Nodes with Hash Key (Ref to Data)        .
IF_ESF_CHANGE_HANDLER          I NOTIFY_CREATE                 Make New BO Node Element Known                              .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I INITIALIZE                    INIT-Pattern: initialization                                .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I MODIFY                        Method for speedup LCP modifications                        .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I QUERY                         QUERY-Pattern: Execution of a query                         .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I RETRIEVE                      ACCESS-Pattern: Retrieve data                               .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I RETRIEVE_BY_ASSOCIATION       ACCESS-Pattern: Retrieve data by association                .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I SET_BREAKPOINT                steuert Debugger                                            .
IF_ESF_CORE_SERVICE_PROVIDER   I UPDATE                        ACCESS-Pattern: update data                                 .
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description                                                 .
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_DESCRIPTOR_TYPE           Returns Descriptor Type                                     .
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_NAME                      Returns Name                                                .
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES            Liefert eine Liste mit allen Eigenschaften zu dieser Entität.
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_PROPERTY_STRING_VALUE     liefert Eigenschaftswert als String                         .
IF_ESF_DESC                    I GET_PROPERTY_STRING_VALUES    liefert alle Eigenschaftswerte als String                   .
IF_ESF_KEY                     I GET_DATA_AS_REFERENCE         Data will be copied to new object!                          .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I ADD_OBJECT_MESSAGE            Add Object Messages (User-Defined Text)                     .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I ADD_OBJECT_MESSAGE_SYMSG      Add Object Messages from SYMSG                              .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE           Add Process Message (User-Defined Text)                     .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I ADD_PROCESS_MESSAGE_SYMSG     Add Process Message from SYMSG                              .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I DELETE_ALL_OBJECT_MESSAGES    Delete All Object Messages                                  .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_BUFFER          I DELETE_OBJECT_MESSAGES        Delete Object Messages                                      .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I FREE                          Deregisters all controls                                    .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I LOG_DELETE                    Delete Log Content                                          .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I LOG_EXCEPTION                 Write Exception into Error Log                              .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I LOG_MESSAGE                   Records Error Message                                       .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I LOG_REFRESH                   Refresh Logging Control                                     .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_CTL             I LOG_TEXT                      Records Error Message                                       .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_HANDLER         I ADD_MESSAGE                   Generate Message and Add to Message Log                     .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_HANDLER         I ADD_MESSAGE2                  Generate Message and Add to Message Log                     .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_HANDLER         I ADD_SYSTEM_MESSAGE            Generate System Message and Add to Message Log              .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_HANDLER         I ADD_SYSTEM_MESSAGE2           Generate System Message and Add to Message Log              .
IF_ESF_MESSAGE_HANDLER         I DELETE_MESSAGES               Delete Messages from Message Log                            .
IF_ESF_PROVIDER_CONTEXT        I GET_LCP_INSTANCE              Read Instance of LCP                                        .
IF_ESF_PROVIDER_TRANSACTION    I AFTER_ROLLBACK                -- Will be deleted. Use AFTER_FAILED_SAVE instead           .
IF_ESF_PROVIDER_TRANSACTION    I BEFORE_SAVE                   -- Will be deleted. Use CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE instead           .
IF_ESF_PROVIDER_VALUE_SET      I GET_VALUE_SET                 - not defined yet !!                                        .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I ADD_SELECT_OPTION             Adds line to range table                                    .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I ADD_SORTING_CRITERIA          Adds sort criterion for an attribute                        .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I CLEAR_SELECT_OPTIONS          Deletes range table                                         .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I CLEAR_SORTING_CRITERIA        Deletes all sort criteria                                   .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I EXECUTE                       Execute Query                                               .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I GET_DESCRIPTOR                Returns Query Descriptor                                    .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I GET_INPUT_PARAMETER_STRUCTURE Returns Structure of Input Parameters                       .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I GET_RESULT_BO_NODE            Returns Result BO Node of Query                             .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I INVALIDATE                    Invalidates and Resets the Query                            .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I SET_MAXIMUM_RESULT_ROWS       Define Maximum Size of Hit List Quantity                    .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I SET_QUERY_OPTIONS             Set Condions for Query                                      .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I SET_SELECT_OPTIONS            Set Table Range                                             .
IF_ESF_QUERY                   I SET_SORTING_CRITERIA          Set Several Sort Criteria                                   .
IF_ESF_QUERY_DESC              I GET_INPARAM_STRUCTURE_DESC    Returns Inparam Structure Descriptor                        .
IF_ESF_QUERY_DESC              I HAS_INPUT_PARAMETERS          Has Input Parameter(s)                                      .
IF_ESF_QUERY_VIEW_CTL          I ADD_META_COLUMN               Add Column to Control                                       .
IF_ESF_QUERY_VIEW_CTL          I DISPLAY_CONTROL               Outputs Column Name on Grid                                 .
IF_ESF_QUERY_VIEW_CTL          I DISPLAY_RESET                 Resets Display                                              .
IF_ESF_QUERY_VIEW_CTL          I FREE                          Deregisters all controls                                    .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I CLEANUP                       Initialize Back-End State                                   .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I CLOSE_CONNECTION              Closes All Connections                                      .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I FLUSH                         Sends Method Queue to Back End                              .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I IS_DIRTY                      Returns State of Method Queue                               .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I SAVE                          Saves All Changes                                           .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_FACADE          I SET_DEBUG                     Switches the Debugger On or Off                             .
IF_ESF_SERVICE_MANAGER_CLIENT  I GET_BO_MOD_CONFIG_NAMES       not implemented                                             .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I CLEAR                         Sets All Fields to Initial Value                            .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_AS_STRING       Gets Value                                                  .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Gets Value                                                  .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I GET_DESCRIPTOR                Returns Structure Descriptor                                .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I IS_ATTRIBUTE_INITIAL          Checks Attribute for Initial Value                          .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Sets Value                                                  .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE               I SIZE                          Returns Structure Size                                      .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_DESC          I CREATE_DATA                   Generates Data Type According to Structure Description      .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_DESC          I CREATE_TABLE                  Generates Table According to Structure Description          .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_DESC          I GET_TYPE_INFORMATION          Returns ABAP Runtime Structure Descriptor                   .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_DESC          I SIZE                          Number of Fields (Top-Level) in Structure                   .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_WDP           I GET_TYPE_INFORMATION          Returns RTTI Structure Descriptor                           .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_WDP           I GET_VALUE_STRUCTURE           Access to Whole Structure (Ref to Data)                     .
IF_ESF_STRUCTURE_WDP           I SET_VALUE_STRUCTURE           Sets Whole Structure (Ref to Data)                          .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I ADD_BOOL_RESULT               Adds a Boolean Result to the Event Object                   .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds a Message to the Event Object                          .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I DETERMINE_ASSIGNMENT          Determines Assigned Functions and Actions                   .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I GET_NEXT_SUBEVENT             Returns Next Subevent (Event Function Act.)                 .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I GOTO_FIRST_SUBEVENT           Sets Pointer to First Subevent                              .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I RETURN_SUBEVENT_RESULT        Accepts Result of Current Subevent                          .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_ACTION                    Explicitly Sets Action                                      .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_CONTROLLER                Sets Controller                                             .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_EVENT                     Sets Event                                                  .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_EVENT_LOG                 Sets Related Event Log Object                               .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_EXPRESSION                Explicitly Sets Expression                                  .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SET_VERSION_TIMESTAMP         Sets Reference Date for Version Determination               .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SUBEVENT_FROM_LOG             Removes Subevent from Log                                   .
IF_EVENT_BRF                   I SUBEVENT_TO_LOG               Writes Subevent to Log                                      .
IF_EVENT_LOG_BRF               I ADD                           Adds Entry to Event Log                                     .
IF_EVENT_LOG_BRF               I CLEAR                         Deletes Event Log                                           .
IF_EVENT_LOG_BRF               I DELETE                        Deletes an Entry in Event Log                               .
IF_EWM_MATERIAL_SEL            I FILTER_PLANT                  Filter Plants                                               .
IF_EW_CIC_CONF_INTERNAL        I BEFORE_SCREEN                 Hook Before CAll Screen                                     .
IF_EW_CIC_CONF_INTERNAL        I CONFIGURE_COMPONENTS          Configures Components                                       .
IF_EW_CIC_CONF_INTERNAL        I GET_COMPONENTS                Delivers Components                                         .
IF_EW_CIC_CONF_INTERNAL        I GET_FRAMEWORK                 Delivers Framework                                          .
IF_EW_OPS_COMPONENT            I GET_PRESENTATION_FIELDS       Provides Presentation Fields                                .
IF_EW_OPS_COMPONENT            I GET_USAGETYPES_FOR_PRESFIELD  Provides Possible Usage Types for Presentation Field        .
IF_EXPO_CHANGENR_VALIDITY      I ADD_CHANGE_NUMBER             Include change number in effectivity                        .
IF_EXPO_CHANGENR_VALIDITY      I ADD_CHANGE_NUMBERS            Include several change numbers in the effectivity           .
IF_EXPO_CHANGENR_VALIDITY      I RETURN_CHANGE_NUMBERS         Revoke change numbers                                       .
IF_EXPO_DATE_VALIDITY          I ADD_DATE_VALIDITIES           Enter several alternative dates in the effectivity          .
IF_EXPO_DATE_VALIDITY          I ADD_DATE_VALIDITY             Enter date in the effectivity                               .
IF_EXPO_DATE_VALIDITY          I ADD_TIMESTAMP_VALIDITIES      Enter several alternative dates in the effectivity          .
IF_EXPO_DATE_VALIDITY          I ADD_TIMESTAMP_VALIDITY        Enter date in the effectivity                               .
IF_EXPO_DATE_VALIDITY          I RETURN_TIMESTAMP_VALIDITIES   Revoke lists of alternative dates                           .
IF_EXPO_GET_PROFILE            I GET_ALL_PROFILE_NAMES         Import All Explosion Profiles with Names                    .
IF_EXPO_GET_PROFILE            I GET_PROFILE                   Import Explosion Profile                                    .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I CLEAR                         Deletes Expression                                          .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I GET_RESULT                    Returns Result                                              .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I GET_SUBEXPRESSION             Returns Result of a Subexpression                           .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I PREPARE                       Creates (Sub)Tree of Expressions                            .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I SET_EVENT                     Sets Event                                                  .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I SET_EXPRESSION                Sets Expression Information                                 .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I SET_PROCESSOR                 Sets Function Processor                                     .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I SET_REUSE_STATUS              Sets Buffer Status                                          .
IF_EXPRESSION_BRF              I TOUCH                         Expression Is Reused                                        .
IF_EXPRESSION_MIP_BRF          I FREE                          Clears Data                                                 .
IF_EXPRESSION_MIP_BRF          I GET_RESULT                    Provides Result                                             .
IF_EXPRESSION_MIP_BRF          I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_EXP_OBJECT_SERVICE          I GET_DEP_OBJECT_FLAG           Object Type has Dependant Objects                           .
IF_EXP_OBJECT_SERVICE          I GET_EXTERNAL_REPRESENTATION   Determines External Key and Description                     .
IF_EXP_OBJECT_SERVICE          I GET_OBJECTS                   Objects for Express Planning                                .
IF_EXP_OBJECT_SERVICE          I GET_OBJECTTYPE_TEXT           Description of object type                                  .
IF_EXTERNAL_SERVICE_TRG        I ASYNC_POSTING                 Asynchronous Update of TRD Business Transactions            .
IF_EXTERNAL_SERVICE_TRG        I CANCEL_NETTING                Cancels Netting                                             .
IF_EXTERNAL_SERVICE_TRG        I CHECK_GROUP                   Checks if Payment Transactions Can Be Paid Together         .
IF_EXTERNAL_SERVICE_TRG        I DO_NOT_POST                   Sets Indicator Do Not Post/Reverse                          .
IF_EXTERNAL_SERVICE_TRG        I SET_BAPI_MODE                 Informs PIN Manager About BAPI Mode                         .
IF_EX_AAPM                     I PM_DETERMINE_ADATU            Determination of Validity Start Date in Table ANLZ          .
IF_EX_ABI_IDOC_PROC_MODIF      I IDOC_CRTN_MODIF               Creation Modifications                                      .
IF_EX_ABI_IDOC_PROC_MODIF      I IDOC_POST_MODIF               Posting Modifications                                       .
IF_EX_ACCL_PAY_MESSAGE         I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Message handling for an Accelerated Pay term                .
IF_EX_ACC_BAPI_BEBD            I FILL_EXTENSION                Fill the Extension2 Structure                               .
IF_EX_ACC_DOCUMENT             I CHANGE                        Change the Accounting Document                              .
IF_EX_ACC_DOCUMENT             I FILL_ACCIT                    Fill Internal Table IT_ACCIT from GS_BAPI_ACCIT             .
IF_EX_ACEPS_ACCDET_STRUC       I ACCDET_STRUCT_FILL            Fills Structure for Account Determination                   .
IF_EX_ACEPS_BAPIDOC_MODIFY     I BAPIDOC_MODIFY                Change the BAPI Document before Transfer to Accounting      .
IF_EX_ACEPS_BAPIPREDOC_MOD     I BAPIPREDOC_MODIFY             Change the 2-Line BAPI Document                             .
IF_EX_ACE_ARCHIVING_PREP       I CHECK_OBJECT_TO_BE_ARCHIVED   Check Whether Accrual Object Is To Be Archived              .
IF_EX_ACE_SOP_HR_DAT_TRANS     I MODIFY_ACCRUAL_ENGINE_DATA    Change Data for Transfer to the Accrual Engine              .
IF_EX_ACE_SOP_TRF_LIST_MOD     I MODIFY_LIST                   Change the Results List                                     .
IF_EX_ACE_SOP_TRF_SUM_MOD      I MODIFY_SUMMARY_LIST           Change Results of the Summation of Lock Periods             .
IF_EX_ACE_UI_NAVIGATION        I NAVIGATE                      Navigation to Any Destination from Accrual Object           .
IF_EX_ACO_APPL_OBJECT_URL      I GET_APPL_OBJECT_URL           Supplies URL of Application Object                          .
IF_EX_ACO_ORG_UNITS            I GET_EVALUATION_PATH           Define Evaluation Path                                      .
IF_EX_ACO_SUBSTITUTES          I GET_LABEL                     Get Description for Object Categories                       .
IF_EX_ACO_SUBSTITUTES          I GET_SUBSTITUTABLE_OBJECTS     Access to objects for which substitute is to be defined     .
IF_EX_ACO_USER_EXTENSION       I USER_COPY                     Copy users                                                  .
IF_EX_ACO_USER_EXTENSION       I USER_DELETE                   Delete User                                                 .
IF_EX_ACTIVATE_CC_SPLIT        I ACTIVATE_SPLIT                Activation of Split After Transaction Balance               .
IF_EX_AC_DOCUMENT              I CHANGE_AFTER_CHECK            FI/CO Document after Addition of AC Components              .
IF_EX_AC_DOCUMENT              I CHANGE_INITIAL                FI/CO Document Prior to Calling AC Components               .
IF_EX_AC_QUANTITY_GET          I EXIT_QUANTITY_CHANGE          ACC Interface: Exit for Changing the Quantity/Quantity Unit .
IF_EX_AC_QUANTITY_GET_EXIT     I EXIT_QUANTITY_CHANGE          Customer Exit for Changing Quantity and Unit of Measure     .
IF_EX_AD01_DPBP_RRDP_PROC      I FILL_AUART_DPR                Fill Sales Document Type for Down Payment Request           .
IF_EX_AD01_DPBP_RRDP_PROC      I FLOW_READ_DPR                 Read Document Flow for Down Payment Request                 .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_COLLECTIVE1     I CHANGE_FIELDCAT               Change Output List Field Catalog                            .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_COLLECTIVE1     I CHANGE_LINE_SIZE              Change Number of Columns for Printing                       .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_COLLECTIVE1     I FILL_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS        Change or Add To Output List                                .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_COLLECTIVE1     I USER_SELECTION                Follow-Up Action when Selecting Field w/ Dbl.-Click/Hotspot .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_REPORTING_1     I CHANGE_FIELDCAT_LAYOUT        Change Field Catalog/Layout of Output List                  .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_REPORTING_1     I FILL_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS        Addition To and Change of Output List                       .
IF_EX_AD01_RRB_REPORTING_1     I USER_SELECTION                Follow-Up Action when Selecting Field w/ Dbl.-Click/Hotspot .
IF_EX_ADAPTER_RFW              I GET_ADAPTER_TEXT              Get Adapter Description                                     .
IF_EX_ADAPTER_RFW              I SELECT_GRAPH                  Selection of Graphs to be Read                              .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_CHECK            I ADDRESS_POSTAL_CHECK          Postal address check                                        .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_CHECK            I IS_ACTIVE_FOR_COUNTRY         Determines whether there is a check for the country         .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SEARCH           I ADDRESS_SEARCH                Error-tolerant address search                               .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SEARCH           I INITIALIZE                    Initialization Method                                       .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SEARCH           I IS_COMPLETE                   Determines whether the index is synchronous to the SAP DB   .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SEARCH           I READ_INDEX_FIELD_LIST         Gets all indexed fields for the logical search pool         .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SUBSCREEN        I ADDR_APPL_SUB_PAI_EXPORT      Data Export PAI                                             .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SUBSCREEN        I ADDR_APPL_SUB_PAI_IMPORT      Data Import PAI                                             .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SUBSCREEN        I ADDR_APPL_SUB_PBO_EXPORT      Data Export PBO                                             .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_SUBSCREEN        I ADDR_APPL_SUB_PBO_IMPORT      Data Import PBO                                             .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_UPDATE           I ADDRESS1_SAVED                Save an organization address                                .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_UPDATE           I ADDRESS2_SAVED                Save a personal address                                     .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_UPDATE           I ADDRESS3_SAVED                Save a contact person address                               .
IF_EX_ADDRESS_UPDATE           I FINISHED                      Saved                                                       .
IF_EX_ADDR_BUPA_TD_READ        I GET_TIME_DEPENDENT_NAME_FIELDSRead Time-Dependent Name Fields                             .
IF_EX_ADDR_LANGU_TO_VERS       I MAP_LANGUAGE_TO_VERSION       Determines international address version for a language     .
IF_EX_ADDR_LANGU_TO_VERS       I MAP_VERSION_TO_LANGUAGE       Determines language for an international address version    .
IF_EX_ADDR_PRINTFORM_SHORT     I ADDR_PRINTFORM_SHORT          Method for Overriding Short Forms                           .
IF_EX_ADDR_REG_SETTINGS        I DETERMINE_SETTINGS            Determination of Settings for Regional Structure            .
IF_EX_ADDR_TXJCD_CHECK         I SWITCH_ADDRESS_FIELDS         Override Address Fields                                     .
IF_EX_ADFSH_MASTER_BADI        I CHECK_DETAIL_RECORDS          Check the detail records                                    .
IF_EX_ADFSH_MASTER_BADI        I CHECK_MASTER_RECORDS          Check the master records                                    .
IF_EX_ADJUST_NET_DAYS          I DETERMINE_NETTERMS            Determine Net Due Date                                      .
IF_EX_ADJUST_UOM_EXT           I ADJUST_UOM                    Adjustment of Quantity Unit in CO for Material              .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_CTXMENU       I CONTEXT_MENU_REQ              Handle context menu request                                 .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_CTXMENU       I CONTEXT_MENU_SEL              Handle context menu selection                               .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_PROC_SELE     I EXPORT_SELECTED_PARTS         Table of selected parts                                     .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_PROC_SELE     I SET_MENU_ICON                 Define icon properties                                      .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_SEL_SCR       I FETCH_DATA_IPDB               Fetch data selection queries                                .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_SEL_SCR       I FETCH_DATA_VIEW               Fetch data for component/end view                           .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_SEL_SCR       I SET_SEL_SCREEN_ICON           Set ICON to display customer selection screen               .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPBRO_SEL_SCR       I SHOW_CUST_SELECTION_SCREEN    Define customer selection screen                            .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_DATE_CONV     I EFFDATE_CONV                  Convert Effective Date from 5 to 8 Characters               .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_HDR_API       I PROCESS_EXTENSION_DATA        Process Customer Extension Data                             .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_PART_API      I PROCESS_EXTENSION_DATA        Process Customer Extension Data                             .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_PART_API      I READ_EXTENSION_DATA           Read Customer Extension Data                                .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_PART_API      I UPDATE_EXTENSION_DATA         Update Customer Extension Data (INSERT into Cust Tables)    .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I GET_VALID_ECS_ADRV            Get list of valid Customer Explanation Code Segments in ADRV.
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I GET_VALID_ECS_PNRV            Get list of valid Customer Explanation Code Segments in PNRV.
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I INITIALIZE_EXTENSION_DATA     Initialize extension data                                   .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I PROCESS_ADRV_EC_SEGMENT       Process Customer Explanation Code Segment in ADRV           .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I PROCESS_EXTENSION_DATA        Process Extension data for Customer Record Types            .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_PARSER      I PROCESS_PNRV_EC_SEGMENT       Process Customer Explanation Code Segment in PNRV           .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_READER      I INITIALIZE                    Initialize user data                                        .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_READER      I READ_RECORD                   Read Customer Record                                        .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_S_READER      I RETURN_PART_DATA              Return User Data for the current part                       .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I GET_VALID_ECS_ADRV            Get list of valid Customer Explanation Code Segments in ADRV.
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I GET_VALID_ECS_PNRV            Get list of valid Customer Explanation Code Segments in PNRV.
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I INITIALIZE_EXTENSION_DATA     Initialize extension data                                   .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I PROCESS_ADRV_EC_SEGMENT       Process Customer Explanation Code Segment in ADRV           .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I PROCESS_EXTENSION_DATA        Process Extension data for Customer Record Types            .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_PARSER      I PROCESS_PNRV_EC_SEGMENT       Process Customer Explanation Code Segment in PNRV           .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_READER      I INITIALIZE                    Initialize user data                                        .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_READER      I READ_RECORD                   Read Customer Record                                        .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_T_READER      I RETURN_PART_DATA              Return User Data for the current part                       .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_PARSER      I PROCESS_EXTENSION_DATA        Process Extension data for Customer Record Types            .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_CBS       Read Customer Field in CBS                                  .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_EIS       Read Customer Field in EIS                                  .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_HEADER    Read Customer Field in Header                               .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_LMS       Read Customer Field in LMS                                  .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_PDS       Read Customer Field in PDS                                  .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_FIELD_PNS       Read Customer Field in PNS                                  .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I READ_CUSTOMER_SEGMENT         Read Customer Segment                                       .
IF_EX_ADS2KIPUPL_V_READER      I RETURN_PART_DATA              Return User Data for the current part                       .
IF_EX_ADSPC_IDOC_PROC_EXT      I IDOC_PROCESS_AFTER_UPDATE     Process IDOC after updates for inbound idoc.                .
IF_EX_ADSPC_IDOC_STATUS        I HANDLE_STATUS                 Handle Idoc status                                          .
IF_EX_ADSPC_IP_ERRREPORT       I GET_IP_DATA                   SPEC2000: Get the data from IP Tables                       .
IF_EX_ADSPC_IP_ERRREPORT       I GET_IP_ERRORLIST              SPEC2000: Get the Error list formed during upload           .
IF_EX_ADSPC_S1NVOICE           I CALCULATE_OCH                 Calculate Other Charges Code for S1NVOICE                   .
IF_EX_ADSPC_S1NVOICE           I CALCULATE_TAX                 Calculate Tax for S1NVOICE                                  .
IF_EX_ADSPC_S2KFILEHANDLER     I INB_DERIVE_CONTROL_RECORD     Populate control record for the SPEC2000 Inbound IDoc       .
IF_EX_ADSPC_S2KFILEHANDLER     I INB_GET_MESSAGES_ONLY         Extract SPEC message and receiver and sender from S2K file  .
IF_EX_ADSPC_S2KFILEHANDLER     I OUT_FILE_FORMATTING           Add the message formats & handlers in outbound S2K message  .
IF_EX_ADSPSC_PR                I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data ( from the screen )                          .
IF_EX_ADSPSC_PR                I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data ( to the screen )                            .
IF_EX_AD_SPC_IP_MD_TAB         I CHANGE_CONDITION_RECORD_DATA  Change Data used for Condition Record Creation              .
IF_EX_AD_SPC_IP_MD_TAB         I CHANGE_INFORECORD_DATA        Change Data used for Inforecord Creation                    .
IF_EX_AD_SPC_IP_MD_TAB         I CHANGE_MATERIAL_DATA          Change Data used for Material Creation                      .
IF_EX_AFABD_CHANGE             I CHANGE                        Change the AFABD structure                                  .
IF_EX_AFTER_TRIP_SETTLEMENT    I CHANGE_TRV_OBJECTS            Change Travel Objects                                       .
IF_EX_AGR_MAINTENANCE_CHCK     I AGR_MNT_CHANGE_CHECK          Checks if You Are Allowed to Change the Agreement           .
IF_EX_AGR_MAINTENANCE_CHCK     I AGR_MNT_COPY_CHECK            Checks if You Are Allowed to Copy the Agreement             .
IF_EX_AGR_MAINTENANCE_CHCK     I AGR_MNT_REDUCED_MODE_CHECK    Checks if Reduced Mode Is Necessary in Agreement Maintenance.
IF_EX_ALERT_CHECK_CONDTN       I CHECK_ROLE_CONDITIONS         Check Subscription Conditions for Users                     .
IF_EX_ALERT_CHECK_CONDTN       I CHECK_USER_CONDITIONS         Check Subscription Conditions for Users                     .
IF_EX_ALERT_DELIVERY           I DECIDE                        Decide Delivery for Users                                   .
IF_EX_ALERT_EXIT               I MODIFY_LONG_TEXT              Edit Long Text                                              .
IF_EX_ALERT_EXIT               I TO_BE_DELETED                 Alert Will Be Deleted                                       .
IF_EX_ALERT_EXIT               I WAS_CONFIRMED                 Alert Confirmed                                             .
IF_EX_ALERT_EXIT_LOCAL_PPF     I GET_ALERT_DATA                Deliver Additional Data for the Alert                       .
IF_EX_ALERT_EXP_DATE           I GET_EXP_DATE                  Set Expiry Date                                             .
IF_EX_ALERT_MODIFY_TEXT        I MODIFY_LONG_TEXT              Change Long Text                                            .
IF_EX_ALERT_TO_BE_DELETED      I TO_BE_DELETED                 Alert Will Be Deleted                                       .
IF_EX_ALERT_TO_BE_ESCALATE     I TO_BE_ESCALATED               Alert is being escalated                                    .
IF_EX_ALERT_UWL_SELECTION      I GET_CATEGORIES                Delivers Alert Categories for the Selection                 .
IF_EX_ALERT_WAS_CONFIRMED      I WAS_CONFIRMED                 Alert Confirmed                                             .
IF_EX_ALERT_XML                I ENHANCE_XML_DOCUMENT          Enhance XML Document                                        .
IF_EX_ALE_FLTOBJ_VALUE_ADD     I FILTER_OBJECT_VALUE_ADD       Extend Filter Values in Distribution Model                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I CHANGE                        Change MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I CREATE                        Create MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I GETDETAIL                     Detailed Data MAM 2.0                                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I GETLIST                       List Selection MAM 2.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM25_CHANGE                  Change MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM25_CREATE                  Create MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detailed Data MAM 2.5                                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM25_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 2.5                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM30_CHANGE                  Change MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM30_CREATE                  Create MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data MAM 3.0                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_001_ORDER         I MAM30_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 3.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_005_TIMECONF      I CREATE                        Create MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_005_TIMECONF      I MAM25_CHANGE                  Change (Unused)                                             .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_005_TIMECONF      I MAM25_CREATE                  Create MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_005_TIMECONF      I MAM30_CREATE                  Create MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_006_GOODSMVT      I CREATE                        Create MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_006_GOODSMVT      I MAM25_CREATE                  Create MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_006_GOODSMVT      I MAM30_CREATE                  Create MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I CHANGE                        Change MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I CREATE                        Create MAM 2.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I GETDETAIL                     Detailed Data MAM 2.0                                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I GETLIST                       List Selection MAM 2.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM25_CHANGE                  Change MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM25_CREATE                  Create MAM 2.5                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detailed Data MAM 2.5                                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM25_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 2.5                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM30_CHANGE                  Change MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM30_CREATE                  Create MAM 3.0                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data MAM 3.0                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_010_NOTIF         I MAM30_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 3.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_015_CODES         I GETDETAIL                     Codes                                                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_015_CODES         I GETLIST                       Notification Types for Code Selection                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_016_CATLGPROF     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Catalog Profile Details                                     .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_016_CATLGPROF     I MAM25_GETLIST                 List of Catalog Profiles                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_016_CATLGPROF     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Catalog Profile Details                                     .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_016_CATLGPROF     I MAM30_GETLIST                 List of Catalog Profiles                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_017_CODEGROUP     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Code Group Details                                          .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_017_CODEGROUP     I MAM25_GETLIST                 List of Code Groups                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_017_CODEGROUP     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Code Group Details                                          .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_017_CODEGROUP     I MAM30_GETLIST                 List of Code Groups                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_018_CLASS         I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Charactertics for a class                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_018_CLASS         I MAM30_GETLIST                 List of Classes                                             .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I CHANGE                        Change of Funct.Location (Installtn-Dismnt. of Equi) MAM 2.0.
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I GETDETAIL                     Detail Data for Functional Location MAM 2.0                 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I GETLIST                       List Selection MAM 2.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM25_CHANGE                  Change of Funct.Location (Installtn-Dismnt. of Equi) MAM 2.5.
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for Functional Location MAM 2.5                 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM25_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 2.5                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM30_CHANGE                  Change of Funct.Location (Installtn-Dismnt. of Equi) MAM 3.0.
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for Functional Location MAM 3.0                 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_030_FUNCLOC       I MAM30_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 3.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I CHANGE                        Change of Equipment (Installation-Dismant. of Equi) MAM 2.0 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I GETDETAIL                     Detail Data for Equipment MAM 2.0                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I GETLIST                       List Selection MAM 2.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM25_CHANGE                  Change of Equipment (Installation-Dismant. of Equi) MAM 2.5 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for Equipment MAM 2.5                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM25_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 2.5                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM30_CHANGE                  Change of Equipment (Installation-Dismant. of Equi) MAM 3.0 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for Equipment MAM 3.0                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_031_EQUIPMENT     I MAM30_GETLIST                 List Selection MAM 3.0                                      .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_040_MEASUREMT     I CREATE                        Generate                                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_040_MEASUREMT     I MAM25_CREATE                  Generate                                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_040_MEASUREMT     I MAM30_CREATE                  Generate                                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I GETDETAIL                     Detail Data for a Measuring Point MAM 3.0                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I GETLIST                       List with Measuring Points MAM 3.0                          .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for a Measuring Point MAM 3.0                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I MAM25_GETLIST                 List with Measuring Points MAM 3.0                          .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for a Measuring Point MAM 3.0                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_041_MEAS_PT       I MAM30_GETLIST                 List with Measuring Points MAM 3.0                          .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I GETDETAIL                     Detail Data for a Partner                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I GETLIST                       List of All Partners Used                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for a Partner                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I MAM25_GETLIST                 List of All Partners Used                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for a Partner                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_050_PARTNER       I MAM30_GETLIST                 List of All Partners Used                                   .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I GETDETAIL                     Detailed data                                               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I GETLIST                       Stock list                                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detailed data                                               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I MAM25_GETLIST                 Stock list                                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data                                                 .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_070_INVENTORY     I MAM30_GETLIST                 Stock List                                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_080_SIGNATURE     I MAM30_CREATE                  Create Signature                                            .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I GETDETAIL                     Detail Data for User                                        .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I GETLIST                       Read User from Customizing                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for User                                        .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I MAM25_GETLIST                 Read User from Customizing                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Detail Data for User                                        .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_090_CUST_USER     I MAM30_GETLIST                 Read User from Customizing                                  .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I GETDETAIL                     Scenario Customizing Details                                .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I GETLIST                       List of Scenarios for Customizing                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I MAM25_GETDETAIL               Scenario Customizing Details                                .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I MAM25_GETLIST                 List of Scenarios for Customizing                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I MAM30_GETDETAIL               Scenario Customizing Details                                .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_095_CUST_SCEN     I MAM30_GETLIST                 List of Scenarios for Customizing                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_COMPONENT         I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_CONTRACT          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_CUSTOMIZING       I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_EQUIPMENT         I CHANGE_EQUIPMENT_HISTORY      Change equipment history                                    .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_EQUIPMENT         I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_FUNCLOCATION      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_GET_MY_ORDERS     I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_INVENTORY         I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_NOTIF_HEADER      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_OBJECTLIST        I GET_ORDER_OBJECTLIST          Get Object List for an Order                                .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_ORDER_HEADER      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_ORDER_LIST        I GET_ORDER_LIST                Get Plant Order List for Designer                           .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_ORDER_LIST        I ORDER_GETLIST                 Get Order List                                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_ORDER_OPER        I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_ORDER_OPER        I GET_ORDER_OPERATION           Get order operation                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_PARTNER           I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_PUSH_DECISION     I NOTIF_PUSH                    Should notification be sent via PUSH?                       .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_PUSH_DECISION     I ORDER_PUSH                    Should order be sent via push?                              .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_SERVERDRIVEN      I REPLICATION_TRIGGER           Request Replication                                         .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_TECH_ADDR         I MAM30_TECH_ADDR_CREATE        Create address for techncial objects                        .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_USER              I READ                          Read Customer-Specific User Data                            .
IF_EX_ALM_ME_USER_DATA         I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill the customer structures for enhancements               .
IF_EX_ALV_GRID_XT              I REFRESH_TABLE_DISPLAY         Refresh ALV Display                                         .
IF_EX_ALV_GRID_XT              I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Initial Call for ALV Grid                                   .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL     I GET_JCO_RFC_DESTINATION       Set RFC Destination of the JCO-RFC Server                   .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL     I GET_NOTIFICATION_TYPE         Set Notification Type                                       .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL     I QUERY_DEBITOR                 Find Possible Customers                                     .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I BEFORE_ITEM_SELECTION         Before the Selection of Open Items                          .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I BEFORE_OUTPUT                 Before the Output of Bills/Payments                         .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I BEFORE_POST                   Before the Posting of a Payment Instruction                 .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I GET_DATA                      Determine Bill and Payment Data                             .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_GET_DATA       I ON_APPROVAL                   When Releasing a Bill                                       .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_NOTIFY         I NOTIFICATION_MODIFY           Change Notification Parameters                              .
IF_EX_APAR_EBPP_NOTIFY2        I CREATE_TEXT                   Create Text for E-mail                                      .
IF_EX_APPLICATION_OHFW         I CHECK_NODE_ACTION             Performs checks for OHF node actions (create/delete/change) .
IF_EX_APPL_OBJ_OHFW            I GET_APPL_OBJ                  Returns OO appl obj corresponding to node type              .
IF_EX_APPL_OBJ_POST_OHFW       I AFTER_COMMIT_WORK             Refreshes the application buffer                            .
IF_EX_APPL_OBJ_POST_OHFW       I POST_APPL_OBJECTS             Posts application objects using application buffer          .
IF_EX_APPL_OHFW                I CHECK_NODE_ACTION             Performs checks for OHF node actions (create/delete/change) .
IF_EX_APPL_OHFW                I GET_SELECTION_REPORT          Gets the application specific node selection report         .
IF_EX_APPOINTMENT              I CREATED                       BADI After Creating an Appointment (FB)                     .
IF_EX_APPOINTMENT              I DELETED                       BADI After Deleting an Appointment                          .
IF_EX_APPOINTMENT              I MODIFIED                      BADI After Changing an Appointment (FB)                     .
IF_EX_APPOINTMENT              I SAVED                         BADI After Saving (Create/Change) an Appointment            .
IF_EX_APPREQUEST_UPDATE        I AT_SAVE                       Save Appropriation Request, When: Dialog                    .
IF_EX_APPREQUEST_UPDATE        I BEFORE_BUSINESS_TRANSACTION   Before Executing a Business Transaction                     .
IF_EX_APPREQUEST_UPDATE        I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Save Appropriation Request, When: Before Updare             .
IF_EX_AQ_QUERY_PROT            I QUERY_PROT                    Logging of Query Activities                                 .
IF_EX_ARCHIEV_CHECK_E          I CHECK_DATA                    Customer-Specific Checks for Plant to Archive               .
IF_EX_ARCHIEV_CHECK_E          I CODE_TO_TEXT                  Assign Text for the Log                                     .
IF_EX_ARCH_CHECK_DEPSTOR_I     I CHECK_DEPSTORE                Check Whether Dependent Shops Exist                         .
IF_EX_ARCH_CHECK_DEPSTOR_I     I CODE_TO_TEXT                  Create Text for Log Based on Indicator                      .
IF_EX_ARCH_ROUTING_EXTERN      I ALL_PATHEXTS_GET              Determine all Path Extensions (for XML Objects)             .
IF_EX_ARCH_ROUTING_EXTERN      I PARAMS2CREP                   Determine Content Repository Using Parameters               .
IF_EX_ARCH_ROUTING_EXTERN      I PARAMS2PATH_EXTENSION         Determine Path Extension Using Parameters (for XML Objects) .
IF_EX_ARCH_ROUTING_INTERN      I FIELDS_GET                    Deliver Customizing Fields                                  .
IF_EX_ARCH_ROUTING_INTERN      I SUBSET_CHECK                  Subset Check for Selections                                 .
IF_EX_ARC_BC_HROBJ_CHECK       I CHECK                         Archivability Check                                         .
IF_EX_ARC_BC_HROBJ_WRITE       I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_ARC_BC_HROBJ_WRITE       I REGISTER_TABLES               Register Additional Tables                                  .
IF_EX_ARC_BC_HROBJ_WRITE       I WRITE                         Write Additional Data in Archive                            .
IF_EX_ARC_CLASS_ADD_TABLE      I ADD_STRUCTURES                Extend the structure definition of an archiving class       .
IF_EX_ARC_FDM_PROC_CHECK       I CHECK                         Check for Archivability                                     .
IF_EX_ARC_FI_ACE_OBJ_WRITE     I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_ARC_FI_ACE_OBJ_WRITE     I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_ARC_FM_FUNRES_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_DICHECK      I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_IBS          I CHECK                         Check Whether Archiving To Take Place                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_IBS          I DELETE                        Delete Data                                                 .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_IBS          I WRITE                         Generate Archive File (Industry Data)                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_PRECHECK     I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EBAN_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_IBS          I CHECK                         Additional Checks in Object MM_EINA                         .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_IBS          I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_IBS          I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive for Object MM_EINA         .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EINA_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_IBS          I CHECK                         Checks Purchasing Document Header                           .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_IBS          I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_IBS          I WRITE                         Writes Additional Data for Purchasing Document Header       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKKO_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKPO_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_EKPO_SEND         I SEND                          Send data to other systems                                  .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_INVBEL_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_INVBEL_WRITE      I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_INVBEL_WRITE      I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_MATBEL_CHECK      I CHECK                         Prüfung der Archivierbarkeit                                .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_MATBEL_WRITE      I DELETE                        Löschen ADD-ON-spezifischer Daten von Datenbank             .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_MATBEL_WRITE      I PREPARE_WRITE                 Vorbereitung zur Archivierung ADD-ON-spezifischer Daten     .
IF_EX_ARC_MM_MATBEL_WRITE      I WRITE                         Schreiben ADD-ON-spezifischer Daten in Archiverungsdatei    .
IF_EX_ARC_OBJECT_ADD_CLASS     I ADD_CLASSES                   Add classes to an archiving object                          .
IF_EX_ARC_OBJECT_ADD_TABLE     I ADD_STRUCTURES                Extend the Structure Definition of an Archiving Object      .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_AUD_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check Archivability of Transaction Data                     .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_AUD_WRITE        I DELETE                        Deletes Additional Data from Database                       .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_AUD_WRITE        I PREPARE_WRITE                 Reads Additional Data from Database                         .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_AUD_WRITE        I WRITE                         Writes Additional Data to Archive                           .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_QUM_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check Archivability of Master Data                          .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_QUM_WRITE        I DELETE                        Deletes Additional Data from Database                       .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_QUM_WRITE        I PREPARE_WRITE                 Reads Additional Data from Database                         .
IF_EX_ARC_PLM_QUM_WRITE        I WRITE                         Writes Additional Data to Archive                           .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_ORDER_CHECK       I CHECK                         Enhance archiving checks in the write phase                 .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_ORDER_DELETE      I DELETE                        Deletes add-on-specific table entries from the database     .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_ORDER_PREPROCESS  I PREPROCESS_CHECK              Enhance the archivability check in the preprocessing program.
IF_EX_ARC_PM_ORDER_WRITE       I WRITE                         Writes add-on-specific data to the archive.                 .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_QMEL_CHECK        I CHECK                         Enhance archivability checks in the write program           .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_QMEL_DELETE       I DELETE                        Deletes add-on-specific table entries from the database     .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_QMEL_PREPROCESS   I PREPROCESS_CHECK              Enhance archivability checks in the preprocessing program   .
IF_EX_ARC_PM_QME_WRITE         I WRITE                         Writes add-on-specific data to the archive.                 .
IF_EX_ARC_P_ORDER_WRITE        I DELETE                        Deletion of Additional Data from Database                   .
IF_EX_ARC_P_ORDER_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write Additional Data in Archive                            .
IF_EX_ARC_QM_SAMPLE_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check Archivability                                         .
IF_EX_ARC_QM_SAMPLE_WRITE      I DELETE                        Deleting Additonal Data from the Database                   .
IF_EX_ARC_QM_SAMPLE_WRITE      I PREPARE_WRITE                 Reading Additional Data from the Database                   .
IF_EX_ARC_QM_SAMPLE_WRITE      I WRITE                         Writing Additional Data to the Archive                      .
IF_EX_ARC_RV_LIKP_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_RV_LIKP_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_RV_LIKP_WRITE        I PREPARE_WRITE                 Prepare for Write                                           .
IF_EX_ARC_RV_LIKP_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_CHECK           I CHECK                         Check the archivability of business objects                 .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_CHECK_INTERN    I IS_CASE_OUTDATED              Checks whether the business transaction is archivable       .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_DELETE          I DELETE                        Delete add-on specific table entries                        .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_DELETE_INTERN   I DELETE                        Deletes table entries by add-on specific criteria           .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_READ_INTERN     I GET_MENU_ITEMS                Get menu items with their event names                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_READ_INTERN     I READ                          Read add-on specific information from the archive           .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_READ_INTERN     I SET_DIALOG_BOX_ATTR           Set the attributes for the dialog box in the "read" dialog  .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_WRITE           I WRITE                         Writes add-on specific data to the archive                  .
IF_EX_ARC_SCMG_WRITE_INTERN    I WRITE                         Writes add-on specific data to the archive                  .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_COND_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_COND_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_COND_WRITE        I RELOAD                        Reload                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_COND_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBAK_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBAK_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBAK_WRITE        I PREPARE_WRITE                 Prepare for Write                                           .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBAK_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBREV_CHECK       I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBREV_WRITE       I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBREV_WRITE       I PREPARE_WRITE                 Prepare for Write                                           .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBREV_WRITE       I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBRK_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBRK_WRITE        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBRK_WRITE        I PREPARE_WRITE                 Prepare for Write                                           .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VBRK_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write                                                       .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VTTK_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check for archivability                                     .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VTTK_DELETE       I DELETE                        Delete archived shipment                                    .
IF_EX_ARC_SD_VTTK_WRITE        I WRITE                         Write method for Archiving shipments                        .
IF_EX_ARC_SRM_GSP_CHECK        I CHECK                         Checks the archivability of business objects                .
IF_EX_ARC_SRM_GSP_CHECK_INTERN I CHECK                         Check the archivability of business objects                 .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_BAPI_EXTEND       I BAPI_ADDITIONAL_PROCESSING    Additional Processing in BAPI After Data Processing         .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_BAPI_EXTEND       I MODIFY_BAPI_DATA              Change Option for Data That Exist in the BAPI (Part 1)      .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_BAPI_EXTEND       I MODIFY_MMD_DATA               Change Option for Data That Exist in the BAPI (Part 2)      .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_DATA_ENRICH       I ADD_MATERIAL_KEYS             Add Additional Key to Material Tables                       .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_DATA_REDUCE       I SUPPRESS_PREFETCH             Suppress Data Prefetch in ARTMAS Distribution               .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_FILTERING         I ADD_FILTER_VALUES             Add Additional Filter Values                                .
IF_EX_ARTMAS_FILTERING         I REMOVE_CHECKBOX_DATA          Do Not Build Checkbox Structures Because of Non-SAP Systems .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT               I CHECK_WRSZ_ASSIGNMENT         Check during assignment of assortment users to assortments  .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST           I CHANGE_POINTER_ANALYSE        Change Pointers for Analysis                                .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST           I IDOC_RECORD_APPEND            Change IDoc Data of an Article                              .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST           I MODIFY_ORGTAB                 Change Organization Table                                   .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD       I CHANGE_IDOC                   Method for Changing Raw IDoc Data                           .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD       I PREFETCH_ALL                  Read Data For Store-Independent Package                     .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD       I PREFETCH_SITES                Read Data For Store-Specific Packages                       .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_2     I FILTER_FOR_IDOC_ENGINE        Filter Articles Before Preparing IDoc                       .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_2     I POINTER_ANALYSE_BDCP2         Exit For Analyzing Condition-Independent CHanges            .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_3     I GROUP_POSITION                Grouping Items For Display And Print Functions              .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_3     I POSITION_FIELDS_MODIFY        Field Modification in the Assortment List Line              .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_3     I POSITION_MODIFY_FOR_DB        Change The Item Before Posting To Database                  .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENTLIST_UPD_3     I SORT_POSITIONS                Sorting Items For Display And Print Functions               .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT_TOOL          I DISPLAY_GROUPING              Display Customer-Specific Groupings                         .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT_TOOL          I DISPLAY_RESTRICTION           Show Customer-Specific Filter Methods                       .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT_TOOL          I SITE_GROUPING                 Structure of Table for Customer-Specific Grouping           .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT_TOOL          I SITE_RESTRICTION              Exectuion of Customer-Specific Filter Methods               .
IF_EX_ASSORTMENT_TOOL          I SITE_SELECTION                Plant Selection                                             .
IF_EX_ASSORT_MAINT             I AT_INIT_ASORT                 Initial Screen Transactions Assortment Maintenance          .
IF_EX_ATP_PUBLISH_RESULTS      I PUBLISH_APO_ATP_RESULTS       publishes the results of the APO availability check         .
IF_EX_ATT_SELECT_BCS           I PROCESS                       Add Attachment                                              .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I GET_CONS_MODE_FROM_T621       Transfer CONS_MODE from T621 to xaupo                       .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_1106     Transport of Data (Subscreen 1106)                          .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_1106       Transport of Data (Subscreen 1106)                          .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I SET_EKPO_PSTYP                Convert Field loc_pstyp                                     .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I SET_POSTAB_CONS_ORDER         Set Indicator for Consignation Proc. in Postal Settlement   .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I SET_WRF_CONS_ORDER            Transfer CONS_ORDER to UP_EKPO                              .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I SET_WRF_CONS_ORDER_FOR_PO     Reservation of CONS_MODE-Feldes in AUBSI and AUUMI          .
IF_EX_AT_CONS_PROCESSING       I SORT_POSTAB                   Additional Sorting by WRF_CONS_ORDER                        .
IF_EX_AT_MTRX_INFO             I AT_PREP_REC_MTRX              Customer_Specific Preparation of Matrix Call                .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_SEARCH        Structural Authorization in Search Function                 .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_VIEW          Check Structural Authorization for an Object                .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I CHECK_AUTH_PLAN1              Check Personnel Authorization                               .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I FILL_DATE_VIEW                Fill Authorization Interval Table for an Object             .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I FILL_HYPER_VIEW               Fill Authorization Relationships Table                      .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_BADI           I GET_PROFILES                  Determine Structural Profile of an Object                   .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_CHECK_ACL      I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check autohrization for specified activity and object       .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_SPROJ          I AT_DEFINITION                 Check for Standard Project Definition                       .
IF_EX_AUTHORITY_SPROJ          I AT_ELEMENT                    Check for Standard WBS Element                              .
IF_EX_AUTH_CHECK_ACL           I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check autohrization for specified activity and object       .
IF_EX_BADICP2                  I METHODE                       text                                                        .
IF_EX_BADICP3                  I METHODE                       text                                                        .
IF_EX_BADICP4                  I METHODE                       text                                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_ADPIC_HANDLE_PO     I POST_PO_EXCHANGE              Handle PO after material exchange took place                .
IF_EX_BADI_ADPIC_HANDLE_PO     I PRE_PO_EXCHANGE               Handle PO before material exchange takes place              .
IF_EX_BADI_ADPIC_IC_PARTS      I CHECK_IC_PARTS                Check Interchangeable Parts                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_ADPIC_IC_PARTS      I GET_INTERCHANGE_PARTS         MPN Material Exchange - Filter materials for exchange       .
IF_EX_BADI_ADSPC_CLASSDATA     I MAINTAIN_CLASSDATA            Maintain classification data                                .
IF_EX_BADI_ADSPC_CLASS_V       I MAINTAIN_CLASSDATA            Maintain classification data                                .
IF_EX_BADI_ADSUB_MVT_TYPES     I ALL_SUBCON_MVT_DETERM         Determination of all used movement types in A&D subcontr.   .
IF_EX_BADI_ADSUB_MVT_TYPES     I SINGLE_MVT_DETERM             Single movement type determination for GI, GR and reversals .
IF_EX_BADI_AIPLOC              I LOGSYS_DETERMINE              Determine Logical System for Cross-System Flow of Goods     .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I ADD_INACTIVE_FIELDS           Add Inactive Fields In Template Handling                    .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I IMPORT_AT_UPDATE_TASK         Import Customer Data In Update Module                       .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I REFERENZ                      Default Data For Template Handling: Time 'Normal'           .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I REFERENZ_AFTER                Default Data For Template Handling: Time 'After'            .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I REFERENZ_BEFORE               Default Data For Template Handling: Time 'Before'           .
IF_EX_BADI_ARTICLE_REF_RT      I TRANSPORT_TO_UPDATE_TASK      Transfering Customer Data To Posting Module                 .
IF_EX_BADI_AUTH_CHECK_KE21     I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Checks Authorization Object Within Line Item Entry          .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_ARCHIVE         I GET_RESULTS                   Transmission of Search Results to Caller                    .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_ARCHIVE         I GET_SETTINGS                  Settings for Archive Evaluation                             .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_ARCHIVE         I SET_ACTIVE                    Transmission of Selection Criteria for System Search as Job .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_ARCHIVE         I SET_ARCHIVES                  Transmission of Selection Criteria for Archive Search       .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_CONV            I CONVERT_FIELD                 Method for Field Content Conversion                         .
IF_EX_BADI_AUT_CONV            I CONVERT_KEY                   Method  for Table Key Conversion                            .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_MASTER_INT    I CHECK_CLASSIF_BEFORE_SAVE     Batch Classification Check When Saving                      .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_MASTER_INT    I CHECK_DATA_BEFORE_SAVE        Check Batch Data at Save                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_MASTER_INT    I SINGLE_FIELD_CONTROL          Field Selection Control                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_NUMBER_INT    I CHECK_BATCH_NUMBER            Check of New Batch Number                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_NUMBER_INT    I GET_BATCH                     Propose Batch                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_NUMBER_INT    I INIT                          Initialization of Batch Number Assignment                   .
IF_EX_BADI_BATCH_NUMBER_INT    I NEXT_BATCH_NUMBER             Assignment of Modification of the New Batch Number          .
IF_EX_BADI_CANCELED_FUND       I METHOD_01                     Update Information for New Document (Document Type and Text).
IF_EX_BADI_CANCELED_FUNDAR     I METHOD_01                     Update Information for New Document (Document Type and Text).
IF_EX_BADI_CATSTCO_ADD_DATA    I GET_DATA                      Get additional data for transfer                            .
IF_EX_BADI_CATSTCO_ADD_DATA    I TRANSFER_DATA                 Transfer additional data to CO                              .
IF_EX_BADI_CCARDEC             I CCARDEC_MASK                  User Exit for Masking Card Number                           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_ALAYER_EXIT     I EXIT_AS_MNTND_EXPLOSION       Exits as-maintained explosion process                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CHK_STATUS      I GET_CHECK_STATUS_EQUI         Change Check Status of Equipment                            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CHK_STATUS      I GET_CHECK_STATUS_FLOC         Change Check Status of a Functional Location                .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CHK_STATUS      I GET_CHECK_STATUS_HOLE         Change Check Status of a Hole                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CHK_STATUS      I GET_CHECK_STATUS_MPL_NODE     Change Check Status of an iPPE Structure Node               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I ACTION_FOR_ADD_COMP           Customer  Action for added components                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I ACTION_FOR_DEL_COMP           Customer  Action for deleted components                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I ACTIVATE_CONSUME_COMP_MODE    Activate Consumption Mode for component Installation        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I ACTIVATE_RESB_CREATE_FOR_NEW  Activates reservation creation mode for new components      .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I ACTIVATE_RESB_DELETE          Activates reservation deletion mode  for deleted components .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I DISPLAY_PF_RESULTS            Display Parts Finder Result                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I GET_ACCT_ASSIGNMENT           Get account assignment (COBL) for goods movement            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I IMPORT_COMP_DATA_CLIST        Interface to import component data into Clist Appl layer    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I PARTS_FINDER                  Parts Finder Functionality                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I SET_INST_LOCATION             Set Installation Location for Component Installation        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_APL       I USE_SOBKZ_FOR_GOODS_MVT       Use Special Stock for Goods Movement Posting of Clist       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I ACTIVATE_CBTN_1               Activate Customer Button 1                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I ACTIVATE_CBTN_2               Activate Customer Button 2                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I ACTIVATE_CBTN_3               Activate Customer Button 3                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I PROCESS_CBTN_1                Execute customer function for Customer Button 1             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I PROCESS_CBTN_2                Execute customer function for Customer Button 2             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I PROCESS_CBTN_3                Execute customer function for Customer Button 3             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I SET_CBTN_1_LAYOUT             Set Text / Icon / Quickinfo for Customer Button 1           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I SET_CBTN_2_LAYOUT             Set Text / Icon / Quickinfo for Customer Button 2           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CLIST_CBTNS     I SET_CBTN_3_LAYOUT             Set Text / Icon / Quickinfo for Customer Button 3           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CUSTR_CHECK     I CONFIG_CHECK_CUSTR            Performs the customer specific check                        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CUSTR_CHECK     I POST_VALIDITY_CHECK_CUSTR     Performs the customer specific check after validity check   .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CUSTR_CHECK     I PRE_VALIDITY_CHECK_CUSTR      Performs the customer specific check before validity check  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CUST_ACTION     I ACTIONS_AFTER_INSTALL         Actions to be performed after Equipment Installation        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_CUST_ACTION     I ACTIONS_AFTER_REMOVE          Actions to be performed after Equipment Removal             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_DISMANT_CHK     I CHECK_AT_DISMANTLE            Performs All Checks at Removal                              .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPLOSION       I CONFIG_CHECK_FILTER_ELEMENTS  Filter: Actual/ Allowed Elements for Config. Check          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPLOSION       I EQUI_CHECK                    Check If Equip. is Relevant (Exception NOT_FOUND)           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPLOSION       I FLOC_CHECK                    Check If Funct.Loc. is Relevant (Exception NOT_FOUND)       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPLOSION       I SGAP_CHECK                    Check If Gap is Relevant (Exception NOT_FOUND)              .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPL_ALWD       I CONFIG_CHECK_FILTER_ELEMENTS  Filter actual / allowed elements for config check           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_EXPL_ALWD       I MPL_NODE_CHECK                Check if MPLnode is relevant or not                         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FID             I GET_FID_TO_MAINTENANCE_OBJECT Get Functional Identifiers for a Maintanance Object         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FID             I GET_FID_TO_NODE               Get Functional Identifiers for an iPPE Node                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FID             I GET_MAINTENANCE_OBJECT_TO_FID Get Maintanance Objects for a Functional Identifier         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FID             I GET_NODE_TO_FID               Get iPPE Nodes for a Functional Identifier                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FID             I READ_MAINTENANCE_OBJECT       Read CCM-Relevant Data for a Maintenance Object             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FULLY_EQUI      I CHECK_MAT_UPD_RESB            Check and Perform Material Update in Reservation            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_FULLY_EQUI      I SWITCH_ERROR_HANDLE           Switch Error Handle                                         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I CREATE_HOLE                   Creates a Hole on DB                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I DELETE_HOLE                   Deletes a Hole on DB                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I GET_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL          Gets one Hole for Installation (--" to outside)             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I INITIALIZE                    Init buffer tables                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I SAVE_ON_DB                    Updates DB                                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I SELECT_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL       Selects one specific structure gaps for IE4N installation   .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I SET_HEADER_MESSAGE            Writes Header Message in Alog                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I SET_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL          Sets one Hole for Installation (-"from outside)             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I UPDATE_FID_EQUI               Compares / Updates FUNCID from Equi / Hole                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_HOLE_UPD        I UPDATE_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL       Updates Hole After Installation                             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INSTALL_CHK     I CHECK_AT_INSTALL              Performs All Checks at Installation                         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I ACTIVATE_INSTLOC_BTN          Activates "Proposal" Button for Installation Location       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I ACTIVATE_VPARTS_BTN           Activates "Proposal" Button for Get Valid Parts             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I CHECK_HOLE_CONFIGURATION      Checks if  structure gap belongs to input configuration     .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I CONVERT_OBJNR_EXTERNAL        Converts OBJNR into Tplnr / Equnr                           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I DETERMINE_INSTALLATION_LOC    Determine Installation Proposal                             .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I DETERMINE_VALID_PART          Determine Allowed Equipment                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I DISPLAY_HOLE_SELECTION        Displays possible Holes for Installation                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I DISPLAY_PROPOSAL_VALUES       Display Values for Materials to be installed                .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INST_PROPSL     I SET_BTN_TEXT                  Set Customer Defined Button descriptions                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I ADD_INTERCHANGEABLE_PARTS     Adds the fully interchangeable parts to all/valid parts     .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I GET_FFF_PARTS_IN_SETS         Finds all interchangeable parts in sets                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I GET_MATNR_EXT                 Get Long Material Number                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I GRID_DISPLAY                  Initialization of Time Since Event                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I MATNR_CONVERSION              Conversion of the material number                           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_INTERNAL        I MATNR_TC_COLWIDTH             Dynamically Adjust the Column Width in Table Control        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_I_BASIC_CHK     I CHECK_PART_BASIC              process basic checks for installation                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_I_CUSTR_CHK     I CHECK_PART_CUSTR              Perform Customer-Specific Checks                            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_I_STATS_CHK     I CHECK_PART_STATUS             Check Parts Status                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_I_STATS_CHK     I SET_HEADER_MESSAGE            Writes Header Message in Alog                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_I_STRCT_CHK     I CHECK_PART_VALIDITY           Checks Part's Validity for Installation                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_MESG_TYPE       I CHANGE_MESSAGE_TYPE           Changes the message type                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_MULTI_LOG       I CHECK_WITH_MULTIPLE_RESULT    Multiple check result                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_NOTIF_GENER     I CREATE                        Create New Notif.                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_NOTIF_GENER     I FILL_CUST_DATA                Fill/ Change Customer-Specific Data                         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_NOTIF_GENER     I MODIFY                        Modify Existing Notif:                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_NOTIF_GENER     I PRINT_NOTIF                   Printout Notification                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_NOTIF_GENER     I SET_HEADER_MESSAGE            Writes Header Message in Alog                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_ORDER_DATA      I GET_ORDER_DATA                Get Order Data                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_PAI_CUST        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_PAI          Customer PAI Logic                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_PBO_CUST        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_PBO          Customer PBO Logic                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_QTY_CHECK       I CONFIG_CHECK_QUANTITY         Performs the quantity check                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_REV_SELECT      I PERFORM_STANDARD_SELECTION    Decides whether standard revision selection is performed    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_REV_SELECT      I UDPATE_STANDARD_SELECTION     Updates standard revision selection                         .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_R_BASIC_CHK     I CHECK_PART_BASIC              Perform basic checks for dismantle                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_R_CUSTR_CHK     I CHECK_PART_CUSTR              Perform Customer-Specific Checks                            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_R_STATS_CHK     I CHECK_PART_STATUS             Check Parts Status                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_R_STATS_CHK     I SET_HEADER_MESSAGE            Writes Header Message in Alog                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_CONV       I CONVERT_TIME                  Convert time and date into another timezone                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_CONV       I GET_TZONE_INTO                Get timezone into which time has to be converted            .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I BADI_GET_RECENT_TIME_INSP     Get Calendar Time of Recent Inspection                      .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I BADI_GET_RECENT_TIME_INST     Get Calendar Time of Recent Installation                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I BADI_GET_RECENT_TIME_NEW      Get Calendar Time of Creation                               .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I BADI_GET_RECENT_TIME_OVHL     Get Calendar Time of Recent Overhaul                        .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I BADI_GET_RECENT_TIME_REPR     Get Calendar Time of Recent Repair                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CCM_TIME_SINCE      I GET_NOTIF_CUST                Get Notification Customizing from CL_CCM_TIME_SINCE_EVENT   .
IF_EX_BADI_CHECK_IN_01         I BADI_CHECK_IN_01              Add Registration Data                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PM_ORDER        I CHANGE_OUTBOUND_DATA          Change outbound data (after conversion to APO format)       .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PM_ORDER        I CHANGE_PMORDER_DATA           Change PM order data (before conversion to APO format)      .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PM_ORDER        I CHANGE_PMORDER_HEADERS        Change PM order headers (after selection)                   .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PS_NETWORK      I CHANGE_NETWORK_DATA           Change network data (before conversion to APO format)       .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PS_NETWORK      I CHANGE_NETWORK_HEADERS        Change network headers (after selection)                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PS_NETWORK      I CHANGE_OUTBOUND_DATA          Change outbound data (after conversion to APO format)       .
IF_EX_BADI_CIF_PS_NETW_IN      I CHANGE_NETWORK_INBOUND        Change Network Data Received from APO                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON01                 CMC user defined Button functionality 1                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON02                 CMC user defined Button functionality 2                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON03                 CMC user defined Button functionality 3                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON04                 CMC user defined Button functionality 4                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON05                 CMC user defined Button functionality 5                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMC_USER_BUTTON     I USER_BUTTON_N                 CMC user defined Button functionality N                     .
IF_EX_BADI_CMP_MANAGEMENT      I CMP_ITEM_SORT                 Sort Invoice Items                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_CMP_PROCESSING      I CMP_COMPLAINT_REASON          Adjustment of Complaints Reason                             .
IF_EX_BADI_CMP_PROCESSING      I CMP_CREDIT_MEMO_CHANGE        Change Billing Documents                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CMP_PROCESSING      I CMP_RETURNS_CHANGE            Change Sales Documents                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_CMP_PROCESSING      I CMP_SORT_TABLE                Resorting of Billing Items                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CM_TW               I METHOD_CHANGE_FDES            Method to Change FDES                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_CONCELIG            I CONC_VALIDATION               Concession Eligibility Validation                           .
IF_EX_BADI_CONF_ACTUAL_COSTS   I CONF_ACTUAL_COSTS_ADD         Additional Confirmation Actual Costs                        .
IF_EX_BADI_COOM_CI_CSLA_IDOC   I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_FILL          Create COAMAS IDoc - Insert Customer-Defined Fields         .
IF_EX_BADI_COOM_CI_CSLA_IDOC   I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_UPDATE        Post COAMAS Idoc - Customer-Defined Fields                  .
IF_EX_BADI_COOM_CI_CSLA_IDOC   I IDOC_TYPE_GET                 Create COAMAS IDoc - Read Customer Enhancement IDOC Type    .
IF_EX_BADI_CO_GRPMAINT_1       I BADI_METH_TEXT_OUTPUT         Output Master Data Texts                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAPPING         I MAP_FIELD                     CPE - Map single Document Field                             .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I FORMDOC_FROM_BAPI             Map customer fields of formula results from BAPI            .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I FORMDOC_TO_BAPI               Map customer fields of formula results into BAPI            .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I FORMINPUT_FROM_BAPI           Map customer fields of formula inputs from BAPI             .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I FORMINPUT_TO_BAPI             Map customer fields of formula inputs into BAPI             .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I PRICEQUOT_FROM_BAPI           Map customer fields of Price Quotations from BAPI           .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I PRICEQUOT_TO_BAPI             Map customer fields of Price Quotations into BAPI           .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMGRPOUT_FROM_BAPI          Map customer fields of term group results from BAPI         .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMGRPOUT_TO_BAPI            Map customer fields of term group results into BAPI         .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMINPUT_FROM_BAPI           Map customer fields of term inputs from BAPI                .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMINPUT_TO_BAPI             Map customer fields of term inputs into BAPI                .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMOUT_FROM_BAPI             Map customer fields of term results from BAPI               .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_MAP_BAPI        I TERMOUT_TO_BAPI               Map customer fields of term results into BAPI               .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3              I CONVERT_PRICING_DATA          CPE - Convert Pricing Data into Name Value Pairs            .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3              I CPE_REQUIRED_CHECK            CPE - Check if CPE Call Is Required for Document            .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_CUS     I GET_PRICING_DATA              CPE - Get Pricing Data from the ERP system                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_CUS     I GET_QUANTITY_DATA             CPE - Get Quantity Conversion Data from the ERP system      .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_CUS     I GET_REFERENCE_DATE            CPE - Get Reference Date from the ERP system                .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_PAR     I GET_PRICING_DATA              CPE - Get Pricing Data from the ERP system                  .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_PAR     I GET_QUANTITY_DATA             CPE - Get Quantity Conversion Data from the ERP system      .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_R3_DATA_PAR     I GET_REFERENCE_DATE            CPE - Get Reference Date from the ERP system                .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_SD_VALID        I SD_VALIDAREA_CHECK            CPE - Check Valid Sales Area of a CPE Object                .
IF_EX_BADI_CPE_SD_VALID        I SD_VALIDAREA_FILL             CPE - Fill Valid Sales Area of a CPE Object                 .
IF_EX_BADI_CUST_HIER           I SET_CUST_HITYP                Sets Customer Hierarchy Type                                .
IF_EX_BADI_CY_AMT_COMPUTE      I CHANGE_AMOUNT_KBED            Method for changing KBED Amount                             .
IF_EX_BADI_DCC_SCREEN_151      I GET_DATA_FROM_INSTANCE        Transport data (from screen)                                .
IF_EX_BADI_DCC_SCREEN_151      I PUT_DATA_TO_INSTANCE          Transport data (to screen)                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_DCC_SCREEN_152      I GET_DATA_FROM_INSTANCE        Transport data (from screen)                                .
IF_EX_BADI_DCC_SCREEN_152      I PUT_DATA_TO_INSTANCE          Transport data (to screen)                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_DIAD_SUBCON_1       I BADI_DIAD_SUBCON_1            Copying of Data in PREQ Text                                .
IF_EX_BADI_DIROT_PRCALC        I CALC_PRIORITY                 Calculate Customer Defined Priority for CMC                 .
IF_EX_BADI_DIROT_SRVPRIO       I GET_COMPARE_STOCK             Get Comparison Stock for Srv. Priority Calc.                .
IF_EX_BADI_DIROT_USVPRIO       I GET_COMPARE_STOCK             Get Comparison Stock for Srv. Priority Calc.                .
IF_EX_BADI_DI_PCS2_1           I DIAD_NEW_SETTINGS             Consider batches and different vendor and valuation typ     .
IF_EX_BADI_DI_PCS2_2           I DIAD_FURTHER_ACTIONS          Further actions and tasks                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_DLV_PRTDATA         I BADI_DLV_PRTDATA              Data Collection for Delivery Note                           .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT         I CALL_REPORT                   Calling of Report to Post the Converted File(s)             .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT         I PROCESS_INPUT_DME             Modification of DME File After Import                       .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT         I PROCESS_OUTPUT_DME            Modification of DME File Before Output                      .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT_ABA     I CALL_REPORT                   Calling of Report to Post the Converted File(s)             .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT_ABA     I PROCESS_INPUT_DME             Modification of DME File After Import                       .
IF_EX_BADI_DMEECONVERT_ABA     I PROCESS_OUTPUT_DME            Modification of DME File Before Output                      .
IF_EX_BADI_DRIES               I METHOD_BADI_DRIES             Description method_badi_dries                               .
IF_EX_BADI_DRIES               I METHOD_BADI_DRIES_2           Description method_badi_dries_2                             .
IF_EX_BADI_EAN_SYSTEMATIC      I CALL_USEREXIT                 Interface User Exit EAN_SYSTEMATIC                          .
IF_EX_BADI_EHSH_PERSID_SCR     I GET_DATA_PAI                  Read Screen Data at Event PAI                               .
IF_EX_BADI_EHSH_PERSID_SCR     I GET_DATA_PBO                  Read Screen Data at Event PBO                               .
IF_EX_BADI_EHSH_PERSID_SCR     I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PAI                           .
IF_EX_BADI_EHSH_PERSID_SCR     I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PBO                           .
IF_EX_BADI_EHS_DG_CONSIST_001  I DG_DETAIL_CONSIST_CHECK       Consistency Checks Dangerous Goods Master (Detail Tables)   .
IF_EX_BADI_EHS_DG_CONSIST_001  I DG_HEADER_CONSIST_CHECK       Consistency Checks Dangerous Goods Master (Header Tables)   .
IF_EX_BADI_EHS_DG_CONSIST_001  I DG_RELEASE_CONSIST_CHECK      Consistency Checks Dangerous Goods Master (Product Release) .
IF_EX_BADI_EHS_DG_SAVE_001     I MODIFY_DG_DATA_BEFORE_SAVING  Change Dangerous Goods Data Before Saving                   .
IF_EX_BADI_EHS_DG_SAVE_001     I MODIFY_DG_RELEASE             Change Data for Product Release                             .
IF_EX_BADI_ENDING_INV          I GET_INVENTORY                 Enter Ending Inventory Value (with Cost Comp. Split)        .
IF_EX_BADI_ENDING_INV          I SET_ACTIVE_FLAG               Set Active Flag for Using BAdI                              .
IF_EX_BADI_ENDING_INV          I SET_ALTN_FLAG                 Set Flag for Reading Procurement Alternatives               .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BGR00          Exit for BGR00: Batch Input Structure for Session Data      .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLF00          Exit for BLF00: Vendor Master                               .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLFA1          Exit for BLFA1: Vendor Master, General Data Part 1          .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLFB1          Exit for BLFB1: Vendor Master, Company Code Data            .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLFB5          Exit for BLFB5: Vendor Master, Dunning Data                 .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLFBK          Exit for BLFBK: Vendor Master, Bank Details                 .
IF_EX_BADI_EXITS_RPRAPA00      I SET_VALUES_FOR_BLFBW          Exit for BLFBW: Vendor Master, Withholding Tax Types        .
IF_EX_BADI_F040_SCREEN_600     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Return Document Header Data                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_F040_SCREEN_600     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Display Document Header Data                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SCREEN_BAS     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SCREEN_BAS     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT     Transport data to class instance attributes                 .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS01       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS01       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT     Transport data to class instance attributes                 .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS02       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS02       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT      Transport data to class instance attributes                .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS03       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS03       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT     Transport data to class instance attributes                 .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS04       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS04       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT      Transport data to class instance attributes                .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS05       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_OBJECT   Transport data from the class instance attributes           .
IF_EX_BADI_FDCB_SUBBAS05       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_OBJECT     Transport data to class instance attributes                 .
IF_EX_BADI_FIAA_DOCLINES       I ADD_DOC_LINES                 Add New Line Items                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_FIAA_DOCLINES       I CHANGE_DOCUMENT               Change Complete Document                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_FIAA_DOCLINES       I CHANGE_DOC_TYPE               Change of Document Type                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_FIAA_TABWA          I SELECT_DEP_AREAS              Selection of Depreciation Areas to Be Posted                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMALE_FIPEX         I INBOUND                       Inbound Exit                                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMALE_FIPEX         I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Exit                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_FMALE_FUNDSCTR      I INBOUND                       Inbound Exit                                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMALE_FUNDSCTR      I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Exit                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I CHECK_DRULE_BEFORE_SAVE       Check entries before save assignments (rule type DRULE)     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I CHECK_DRULE_ENTRY             Check single assignment (rule type DRULE)                   .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I DERIVE                        Perform a BAdI type enhancement derivation step             .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Populate customer fields in FMDERIVE                        .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I GET_STRATEGY                  Get  Strategy                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I SET_DISPLAY_MODE              Set Display Mode (Edit/View)                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I SET_STRATEGY_BUTTONS          Options to control available features at strategy level     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I STEP_ACTIVITY_CHECK           Check activity for each step rule                           .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I STEP_CHECK_ON_ENTER           Check step before entering to maintain/display              .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I STEP_CHECK_ON_EXIT            Check step before leaving maintain/display                  .
IF_EX_BADI_FMDERIVE            I STEP_DRULE_ACTIVITY_CHECK     Authority-Check rule type DRULE                             .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_NODE_INS_CHCK I CHECK_ADDRESS_COMPATIBLE      Check whether an address is compatible with its father      .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_READ_MD       I READ_CMMTITEM                 Read hierarchy data for commitment item                     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_READ_MD       I READ_FUNCAREA                 Read hierarchy data for functional area                     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_READ_MD       I READ_FUND                     Read hierarchy data for fund                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_READ_MD       I READ_FUNDSCTR                 Read hierarchy data for funds center                        .
IF_EX_BADI_FMHIE_READ_MD       I READ_MEASURE                  Read hierarchy data for funded program                      .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I CHECK_DRULE_BEFORE_SAVE       Check entries before save assignments (rule type DRULE)     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I CHECK_DRULE_ENTRY             Check single assignment (rule type DRULE)                   .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I DERIVE                        Derivation Step as Enhancement                              .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Populate customer fields in FMSPLIT_DERIVE                  .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I GET_STRATEGY                  Get  Strategy                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I SET_DISPLAY_MODE              Set Display Mode (Edit/View)                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I SET_STRATEGY_BUTTONS          Options to control available features at strategy level     .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I STEP_ACTIVITY_CHECK           Check activity for each step rule                           .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I STEP_CHECK_ON_ENTER           Check step before entering to maintain/display              .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I STEP_CHECK_ON_EXIT            Check step before leaving maintain/display                  .
IF_EX_BADI_FMSPLIT_DERIVE      I STEP_DRULE_ACTIVITY_CHECK     Check activity for maintaing/display DRULE values           .
IF_EX_BADI_FM_FM2AC            I FM_FMAC_DERIVE_SPECIFIC       Derive specific data for transfer FM to AC                  .
IF_EX_BADI_FM_FM2AC            I FM_FMAC_FI_DOCUMENT_TYPE      Specify the FI document type                                .
IF_EX_BADI_FM_FM2AC            I FM_FMAC_GET_CTRL_PARAMETER    Control parameter for transfer FM to AC                     .
IF_EX_BADI_FM_USE_ASSIGN       I FILL_FLAG                     Indicator to execute FM Assignment and Validation           .
IF_EX_BADI_FRML_CALC           I CALCULATE_FORMULA             Calculate Inputs and Outputs of a Formula                   .
IF_EX_BADI_FVD_LOCAC_CHECK     I CHECK_IL                      Check Installment Loan                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_FVD_MZDAT           I MZDAT_SET                     Fill Table MZDAT                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I CHECK_DRULE_BEFORE_SAVE       Einträge vor Sichern der Zuordnungen prüfen (Regelart DRULE).
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I CHECK_DRULE_ENTRY             Einzelne Zuordnung prüfen (Regelart DRULE)                  .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I DERIVE                        Perform a BAdI type enhancement derivation step             .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Populate customer fields in GMDERIVE                        .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I GET_STRATEGY                  Strategie für FMM-Ableitungswerkzeug ableiten               .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I SET_DISPLAY_MODE              Set Display Mode (Edit/View)                                .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I SET_STRATEGY_BUTTONS          Options to control available features at strategy level     .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I STEP_ACTIVITY_CHECK           Check activity for each step rule                           .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I STEP_CHECK_ON_ENTER           Check step before entering to maintain/display              .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I STEP_CHECK_ON_EXIT            Check step before leaving maintain/display                  .
IF_EX_BADI_GMDERIVE            I STEP_DRULE_ACTIVITY_CHECK     Authority-Check rule type DRULE                             .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GAAPPOST         I ADJUST_ASSIGNMENTS            Adjust Assignments to accrual entries                       .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GAAPPOST         I ADJUST_SELECTED_ENTRIES       Adjust selected entries before document is calculated       .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GMREP            I GM_EXTEND_GMRGRL              Fill extended grant reporting structure                     .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GMREP            I GM_EXTEND_GMRGSL              Fill extended grant sponsor reporting structure             .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GMREP            I GM_EXTEND_GMRSCL              Fill extended sponsored class reporting structure           .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_GMREP            I GM_EXTEND_GMRSPL              Fill extended sponsored program reporting structure         .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_IDCPOST          I CHECK_IDC_RELEVANT            Check if record is IDC Relevant                             .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_IDCPOST          I FILL_CALC_CO_OBJECTS          Fill cost assignments in calculated IDC                     .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_IDCPOST          I FILL_CO_OBJECTS               Fill alternative CO objects                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_REV_CFACTORS     I GM_REV_ALLOW_FACTORS          Allow user to input exchange rate factors                   .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_REV_VT           I SET_VALUETYPES                Set value types for revaluation of currency                 .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_RRB              I FILL_CO_OBJS                  Fill alternative CO objects                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_RT_DATE          I DEFINE_END_DATE               Define end date                                             .
IF_EX_BADI_GM_RT_DATE          I DEFINE_START_DATE             Define start date                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_02              I PEG_EXCESS                    Pegging: Distribution of Excess                             .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_03              I PEG_SCRAP                     Pegging: Distribution of Scrap                              .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_04              I PEG_LOSTFOUND                 Pegging: Assignment of Stock Deviations                     .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_05              I CHECK_AND_ADJUST_ASS          Pegging: Check and Adjust Assignments                       .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_06              I DETERMINE_BREAKPOINT          Pegging: Determination of Breakpoint                        .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_08              I SAVE_DIST_HISTORY             Save Distribution History                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_08_PEG          I BEFORE_DATABASE_UPDATE        Pegging: Called direct before the database update           .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_09              I BEFORE_DATABASE_UPDATE_DIS    Pegging: Called before database update of distributed values.
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_10              I BEFORE_DATABASE_UPDATE_IMP    Changing pegs before database update                        .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_12              I PEG_EXCESS                    Distribution of surplus                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_16              I ADD_PEG_STK_FOR_STO           transfer posting from intransit to in-stock (reverse 352)   .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_16              I ADD_PEG_STK_FOR_STO_RECEIPT   goods receipt processing method for STO's 101               .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_16              I CHANGE_DATE                   change date during in-transit movemnt                       .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_16              I CHANGE_DATE_TSTK              change date during one step cross plant movement            .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_17              I CHECK_AND_ADJUST_TASS         Pegging: Check and Adjust Assignments                       .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_18              I DETERMINE_TECO_PEGGING_LOGIC  Determine pegging logic for TECO (technically complete)order.
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_18              I GET_DATA                      Customer logic to read in more data before pegging          .
IF_EX_BADI_GPD_19              I READ_MAT_GRP_SEGMENT          Read data for one material-group segment before pegging     .
IF_EX_BADI_GTIN_VARIANT        I CALL_USEREXIT                 Customer-Specific GTIN Variant Check                        .
IF_EX_BADI_HMXCISR0_003        I HMXCISR0_003                  Changes wage credit and values related to proportion        .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_ALWD_PM          I METHOD_PACKING_MAT            Reduction of or Indiv. Determin. of Allowed Pckg. Matl Types.
IF_EX_BADI_HU_AUTOPACK         I METHOD_PREPARE                Preparations for Determining Packing Proposals              .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_AUTOPACK         I METHOD_PROPOSAL               Changing and Creating Packing Proposals                     .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_CHANGE_INPUT     I CHANGE_INPUT                  Change to HU Input                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I DEFINITION_SUBSCREEN          Determine Subscreen to be Called                            .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I EXCLUDE_FUNCTIONS             Deactivate Function Codes                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I FCODE_6000                    Processing Routine for Function Codes in Main Screen 6000   .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I FCODE_6100                    Processing Routine for Function Codes in Detail Screen 6100 .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I FCODE_TREE                    Processing Routine for Function Codes in Tree Display       .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I SCREEN_ATTRIBUTES             Modification of Field Attributes                            .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_DIALOG           I STATUS_GET                    Determin the Current Status                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_PACKING_ALWD     I BADI_HU_PACKING_ALWD          Check Whether Packing an Item into an HU Is Allowed         .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_PRINT            I BADI_HU_PRINT                 Makes Data Available for HU Label                           .
IF_EX_BADI_HU_VL10_EXCLUDE     I EXCLUDE_HANDLING_UNITS        Exclude Handling Unit from Assignment List                  .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_ARCHIVE       I CHECK_IBASE_ARCHIVE           Checks Before IBase Archiving                               .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_CHECK         I CHECK_IBASE_HEAD              Additional Checks When Modifying Installed Base Headers     .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_COMP_CHCK     I CHECK_IBASE_COMP              Additional Checks When Modifying IBase Components           .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_COMP_DEL      I CHECK_COMP_DEL                Additional Checks When Deleting Components                  .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_COMP_PST      I CHECK_IBASE_PASTE             Additional Checks When Pasting IBase Components             .
IF_EX_BADI_IBASE_SAVE_CHCK     I CHECK_SAVE                    Additional Checks When Saving IBases                        .
IF_EX_BADI_INMA_INFLATION      I PROCESS_INFLATION_CLASS       Get inflation class                                         .
IF_EX_BADI_INV_PRTDATA         I BADI_INV_PRTDATA              Data Procurement Invoice                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_INV_PRTDATA         I PRC_PRINT_HEAD                Pricing Communication Structure for RV_PRICE_PRINT_HEAD     .
IF_EX_BADI_INV_PRTDATA         I PRC_PRINT_ITEM                Pricing Communication Structure for RV_PRICE_PRINT_ITEM     .
IF_EX_BADI_IPAC                I METHOD_COLLECTION             Add-In logics for extracting 'Collection' info              .
IF_EX_BADI_IPAC                I METHOD_IPACED                 IPACed by SD invoice and MM PO from 'Download'              .
IF_EX_BADI_IPAC                I METHOD_IPACED_FI_INV          IPACed process - extract associated FI invoices             .
IF_EX_BADI_IPAC                I METHOD_PAYMENT                Add-In logics for extracting 'Payment' info                 .
IF_EX_BADI_ISA_REPL_CAT        I INSTANCE_GET                  Returns an instance of the implementing catalog class       .
IF_EX_BADI_ISPS_GRANT          I GMIA_CANCEL                   Reset Billing Document Status when Billing Request Cancelled.
IF_EX_BADI_ISPS_GRANT          I GM_EXP_DLI                    Write DLIs to Memory                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MBGB            I CRP_CALC_A                    CRP Calculation for Material transfers                      .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MBGB            I CRP_CALC_B                    CRP Calculation for Material Issues                         .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MBGB            I SET_FLAG_CRP                  Check if CRP Active                                         .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_DETERMINE_RECID           Determine Recovery indicator                                .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_FSEG_ERST_1               fseg_create #1                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_FSEG_ERST_2               fseg_create #2                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_FSEG_ERZ_1                fseg_create #1                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_FSEG_ERZ_2                tseg_create #2                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_UML_CONDA                 Stock Transfer A                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JVA_UML_CONDB                 Stock Transfer B                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_CAL_ON_OFF             CRP calculation into DM07M                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_KNUMV_GET              Get CRP Document Number                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_KOMV_CLEAR             Clear CRP Data                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_POST                   Post CRP Data                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_PRICING                Call CRP Pricing                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_PRICING_DIALOG         Call CRP Pricing as Dialog                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_JVA_MM07M           I JV_CRP_SAVE                   Save CRPCAL Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CANCEL_TREATMENT              Modification cancel flag                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CRE_MOD7_ADDINFO              Filling additional information for modelo 7                 .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CRE_MOD8_ADDINFO1             Filling additional information for modelo 8 - part 1        .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CRE_MOD8_ADDINFO2             Filling additional information for modelo 8 - part 2        .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CRE_MOD9_ADDINFO1             Filling additional information for modelo 9 - part 1        .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I CRE_MOD9_ADDINFO2             Filling additional information for modelo 9 - part 2        .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLEGALREPORT     I ESPECIE_INDICATOR_CHANGE      Filling the NF: species (column 'especie')                  .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLFA1            I DETERMINE_REC56_FIELDS        Determine Fields for Record Type 56                         .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLFA1            I PROCESS_MATERIAL_NUMBER       Process material number for report                          .
IF_EX_BADI_J_1BLFD1            I DETERMINE_DI_NUMBER           Determination of the Import declaration number              .
IF_EX_BADI_LAYER               I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          get data from screen                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_LAYER               I IS_LAYER_CHANGEABLE           get attribute changeable                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_LAYER               I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            put data to screen                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_LAYER               I SET_LAYER_CHANGEABLE          set attribute changeable                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_LAYER               I SORT_DATA                     sort the data read from db                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_LC_UPDATE           I CHANGE_AFTER_READ             Read / Change data after read of the Basic L/C Data         .
IF_EX_BADI_LC_UPDATE           I CHANGE_AT_COPY                Change data after copy                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_LC_UPDATE           I CHANGE_AT_UPDATE              Update additional customer data                             .
IF_EX_BADI_LC_UPDATE           I CHANGE_DATA                   Change / Check data after Return                            .
IF_EX_BADI_LC_UPDATE           I CHANGE_INCOMPLETION_LOG       Change / Add fields for incompleteness log                  .
IF_EX_BADI_LE_QUANT            I QUANT_POSTING_CHANGE          Quant Determination During Stock Transfer                   .
IF_EX_BADI_LE_SHIPMENT         I AT_SAVE                       Process Shipments During "At Save" Context                  .
IF_EX_BADI_LE_SHIPMENT         I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Process Shipments During "Before Update" Context            .
IF_EX_BADI_LE_SHIPMENT         I IN_UPDATE                     Process Shipments During "In Update" Context                .
IF_EX_BADI_LMOB_VAS_ORDER      I DISPLAY_VAS_ORDER             Display relevant VAS Orders                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I CONDITION_CHECK_RESULT_FILTER Filter Condition Check Results Before VAS Order Creation    .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I REF_DOC_ITEMS_FILTER          Filter Out Ref. Document Items Before Conditions Checks     .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I VAS_ORDER_CONFIRM_COMPLETE    Call Related Processes After VAS Order Confirmation         .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I VAS_ORDER_CREATION_COMPLETE   Call Related Processes After VAS Order Creation             .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I VAS_ORDER_USE_VALIDATE        Validate VAS Order Use and Reverse If Required              .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I VAS_TEMPLATE_ATERNATIVE_SELECTSelect Alternative VAS Template in VAS Order Creation       .
IF_EX_BADI_LXVAS               I WORK_CENTER_PRIORITY_CHANGE   Change Work Center Priority Before VAS Order Creation       .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_001              Determination of AHD-Relevant MRP Types                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_002              Loading of AHD from Customer Data Sources                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_003              Place Filter on the AHD Articles to be Loaded               .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_004              Fill Customer Column in ALV Grid for AHD Display            .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_005              Determine Data to Display and Popup Size for AHD Display    .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_006              Fill Selection Table for Reading AHD from BW Using CL       .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_007              Correction of Replenishment Lead Time in Forecast           .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_008              Adjustment of BW Periods                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD                I EX_BADI_MAHD_009              Check Whether AHD Is Active                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF_CHECK_AHD   Read Whether AHD_ACTIVE                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF_CONS_READ   Read Alternative Historical Time Series Instead of DVER     .
IF_EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_MAHD_INTF_DISP_CHNG   Display/Change Alt. Historical Time Series for MRP Area     .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_ALE_CR     I CHANGE_MATMAS                 Base method                                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_ALE_IN     I CHANGE_UEB_TAB                Edit. of UEB tables before call up of MATERIAL_MAINTAIN_DARK.
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I CHECK_CHANGE_MARA_MEINS       Check for Changes to Base Unit of Measure                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I CHECK_CHANGE_PMATA            Check Change of Pricing Material MARA + MVKE                .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I CHECK_DATA                    For checks and limited changes to material master tables    .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I CHECK_DATA_RETAIL             Check Additional Retail Data                                .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I CHECK_MASS_MARC_DATA          Checks Within FB MATERIAL_CHECK_LOGISTIC_DATA               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_CHECK      I FRE_SUPPRESS_MARC_CHECK       Suppress Certain MARC Checks for F&R Connection             .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I CHANGE_CHECK_OTHER_MAT_DATA   Check Whether Integrated Material Data Was Changed          .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I GET_OTHER_MATERIAL_DATA_BILD  Fill Work Area for Integrated Objects in Material Master    .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_DIFFMAINT_ORGLEVS_OD Determine Deviating Fields for Integrated Data              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_GET_DIFFERENCES_OD_RTDetermine Deviations for Integrated Data                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_POST_OTHER_DATA      Post Integrated Material Data                               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_PREPARE_POSTING_OD   Prepare Integrated Material Data for Posting                .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_REFCHANGE_OD_RT      Pass On Templates for Integrated Data                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MATERIAL_REFERENCE_OD_RT      Determine Template Data for Integrated Data                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I MG_IDOC_CREATE_FULL           Create IDocs of Dependent Components                        .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I PF_STATUS_SETZEN              Set GUI Status for Integrated Objects                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I READ_OTHER_MATERIAL_DATA      Read Data of Integrated Objects in Material Master          .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I SET_OTHER_MATERIAL_DATA_BILD  Buffer Work Area for Integrated Objects                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MATERIAL_OD         I SET_PROGRAM_FOR_OKCODE_ROUTN  Set Program of Integrated Processing Routine                .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_ART_CL       I ARTICLE_ASSIGNM_CL            Classification of a Unique Material Assignment              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_ATTR_CHK     I ATTR_ASSIGNM_CHECK            Check of Attribute-Node Assignment                          .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_ATTR_CHK     I ATTR_MANDATORY_CHECK          Check Whether Attribute Assignment Is Required              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_ATTR_CHK     I ATTR_MULTI_ASSIGNM_CHECK      Check Whether Multiple Attribute Assignment Is Allowed      .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_ATTR_CHK     I ATTR_RESTRICT_ASSIGNM_CHECK   Check Whether Attrib. Can Only Be Assigned to Certain Nodes .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_CHANGE       I CHANGE_MATGRP_CUST            Method for Custom Data Formatting                           .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_CREATE       I CREATE_MATGRP_CUST            Method for Custom Data Formatting                           .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_DETAIL       I GET_DETAIL_MATGRP_CUST        Method for Custom Data Formatting                           .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIERACHY     I HIERARCHY_EVENT_INTERFACE     Method for Level-Specific Implementation                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIERACHY     I HIERARCHY_NODE_ID_CUST        Method for Level-Specific Account Numbering                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I ARTICLE_ASSIGNM_ATTR_CHECK    Check Material Assignments of Hierarchy Attributes          .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I ARTICLE_ASSIGNM_CHECK         Check Material Assignments                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I ARTICLE_ASSIGNM_VALIDITY_CHECKCheck the Validity Periods of Material Assignments          .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I ARTICLE_MAIN_ASSIGNM_CHECK    Check Main Assignments                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I ARTICLE_MANDATORY_CHECK       Check Whether Material Assignment Is Required               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I NODE_ASSIGNM_CHECK            Check Node Assignments                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I NODE_ASSIGNM_VALIDITY_CHECK   Check the Validity Periods of Node Assignments              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I NO_PLANED_HIER                Forbid Shop Assignments to Planned Hierarchies              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I VALIDITY_CHECK_FOR_ARTICLE    Check Validity Periods of Assignments                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_CHK     I VALIDITY_PERIOD_CHECK         Check Validity Periods of Assignments                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_LEV     I HIERARCHY_EVENT_INTERFACE     Method for Level-Specific Implementation                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_LEV     I HIERARCHY_NODE_ID_CHECK       Method for Level-Specific Node ID Check                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_LEV     I HIERARCHY_NODE_ID_GET         Method for Level-Specific Account Numbering                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_HIER_LEV     I HIERARCHY_XML_FORMAT          Method for XML Download                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_PRODHIER     I AT_ACTIVATION_CHECK           Activation of Material Hierarchy (Prod. Hier. Check)        .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_PRODHIER     I AT_ACTIVATION_SAVE            Activation of Material Hierarchy (Prod. Hier. Link)         .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_PRODHIER     I AT_CHANGE_CHECK               Copy Material Hierarchy Changes (Prod. Hier.)               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_PRODHIER     I AT_CHANGE_SAVE_NODE           Copy Material Hierarchy Changes (Prod. Hier.)               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATGRP_PRODHIER     I AT_CHANGE_SAVE_SKU            Copy Material Hierarchy Changes (Prod. Hier.)               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATMAS_ALE_CR       I CHANGE_MATMAS                 Base Method                                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATMAS_ALE_IN       I CHANGE_UEB_TAB                Base Method                                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATN1               I MATN1_INPUT_001               Number Conversion Input Start                               .
IF_EX_BADI_MATN1               I MATN1_INPUT_002               Number Conversion Input Finish                              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATN1               I MATN1_OUTPUT_001              Number Conversion Output Start                              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATN1               I MATN1_OUTPUT_002              Number Conversion Output Finish                             .
IF_EX_BADI_MATNR_CHECK_PVS     I CHECK_MARA                    Material Number Check                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATNR_CHECK_PVS     I CHECK_MARA_MARC               Check Material Number/Plant                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATNR_CHECK_PVS     I CHECK_MARA_MEINS              Check Material Number/Unit of Measure                       .
IF_EX_BADI_MATRIX              I NODE_INFO_SHOW                Detail Display for Matrix Node                              .
IF_EX_BADI_MATRIX_I            I FCODE_EXLUDE_LIST_CHANGE      Change List of Excluded FCodes in List Mode                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MATRIX_SORT         I SORT_AXIS_ALLOCATION          Sorting of axis allocation of the matrix                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MAT_F_SPEC_SEL      I SPECIAL_FIELD_SELECTION       Special Field Selection for T130F-SFGRU = '999'             .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_001              Customer-Specific Determination of Receiving MRP Areas      .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_002              Adjust Result to Standard Methods for Receiving MRP Areas   .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_005              Set references for the delivery relationship                .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_006              Customer Check of MRP Type                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_007              Customer Check of Source of Supply                          .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_009              Check Manually Entered Recipients                           .
IF_EX_BADI_MDRD                I EX_BADI_MDRD_010              Customer-Specific Reading of Delivery Relationships         .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MARA                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MARA                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MARC                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MARC                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MARD                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MARD                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MBEW                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MBEW                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MLGN                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MLGN                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MLGT                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MLGT                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I ARCHIVE_MVKE                  Archive + Delete Additional Data for MVKE                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MARA                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MARA                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MARC                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MARC                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MARD                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MARD                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MBEW                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MBEW                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MLGN                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MLGN                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MLGT                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MLGT                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I CHECK_MVKE                    Check Additional Data for Archiving MVKE                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_MATNR            I READ_ARCHIVE                  Reading of Archive Content in Deletion Run                  .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PO_SC_SRV        I MAINTAIN_SRV_FOR_SC           Service tab page for subcontracting item                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PRIO_ORG         I MRP_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE        Determine Organizational Priority During Reqmts Planning    .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PRIO_ORG         I PM_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE         Determine Organizational Priority During Maintenance        .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PRIO_ORG         I PO_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE         Determine Organizational Priority in Orders                 .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PRIO_ORG         I PR_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE         Determine Organizational Priority in Purchase Requisitions  .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_PRIO_ORG         I RES_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE        Determine Organizational Priority in Reservations           .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I ARCHIVE_MCH1                  Archiving and Deletion of Additional Data for MCH1          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I ARCHIVE_MCHA                  Archiving and Deletion of Additional Data for MCHA          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_BATCH_MASTER            Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MCHA          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_EBEW                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for EBEW          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MCHB                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MCHB          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MKOL                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MKOL          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MSKA                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MSKA          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MSKU                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MSKU          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MSLB                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MSLB          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_MSPR                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for MSPR          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I CHECK_QBEW                    Checking of Additional Data for Archiving for QBEW          .
IF_EX_BADI_MM_SPSTOCK          I READ_ARCHIVE                  Reading of Archive Content in Deletion Run                  .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_MP_GENER        I ADD_ADDITIONAL_DATA_CRT       Add additional data to the maintenance plan creation        .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_MP_GENER        I ADD_ADDITIONAL_DATA_UPD       Add additional data to the maintenance plan update          .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_MP_GENER        I MP_CREATE                     Create maintenance plan                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_MP_GENER        I MP_UPDATE                     Updates maintenance plan                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_REPORTING       I CHANGE_IMPL_REPORT            Data Processing for Change Implementation Reporting         .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_REPORTING       I COMPLIANCE_REPORTING          Data Processing for Total Compliance Reporting              .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_REPORTING       I CONSISTENCY_REPORT            Data Processing for Consistency Reporting                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MPD_REPORTING       I WORK_STATUS_REPORT            Data Processing for Work Status Reporting                   .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I CALLBACK_FROM_MESSAGE_LOG     Called by Message Log when Details are Required             .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I CHECK_VALID_PARTS_MULT_LOC    Checks Multiple Functional Locations                        .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_ALL_PARTS_PER_LOC         Deliver All Parts                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_CLASSIFICATION            Delivers Classification Data of a Functional Location       .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_FILTER                    Delivers List of iPPE Filter Objects                        .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_MOD_DOC_LIST              Delivers All Change Documents                               .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_PRODUCT_STRUCTURE         Delivers the Navigation Structure for the MPL               .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_SUPERIOR_STRUCTURE        Gets All Predecessor Nodes                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I GET_VALID_PARTS_PER_LOC       Delivers Valid Parts per Functional Location                .
IF_EX_BADI_MPL_IWB             I REQUEST_PARTS_FROM_APPLICATIONAdditional Details on Parts/Functional Location Required    .
IF_EX_BADI_MRP_LIST            I FURTHER_PROCESSING_MRP_LIST   Further Processing of MRP List                              .
IF_EX_BADI_OCWB_REVERSAL       I CHECK_REVERSAL                Check to determine whether payment can be cancelled         .
IF_EX_BADI_PCA_BILANZ_1        I FILL_PROFIT_CENTER            Add Profit Center                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_PCA_BILANZ_2        I FILL_PROFIT_CENTER            Add Profit Center                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_01              I CHECK_MRPSETS_BEFORE_DELETING Check All MPN-MRP Sets for Parts to Be Deleted              .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_02              I CREATE_FFF_CLASS_BEFORE_SAVINGAutomatic Creation of an FFF Class Before Saving            .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_03              I DELETE_FFFCLASS_WHEN_EMPTY    Set Deletion Indicator for Empty FFF Classes                .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_04              I MRP_GET_NEXT_NUMBER_FOR_MRPSETDetermine Next Free Number for an MPN-MRP Set               .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_05              I CONSISTENCY_CHECK_MRPSET      Additional Consistency Checks in MPN-MRP Set                .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_06              I REMOTE_CALL_INTERFACE_MRPSET  Accessing of External Systems with Transfer of MPN-MRP Set  .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_07              I REMOTE_CALL_INTERFACE_FFFCLASSAccessing of External Systems with Transfer of Full Interch..
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_08              I REMOTE_CALL_INTERFACE_RESTRICTAccessing of Ext. Systems with Transfer of Restrict.Interch..
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_09              I CONSISTENCY_CHECK_FFFCLASS    Consistency Check When Changing FFF Classes                 .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_10              I CHECKS_ON_EXTERNAL_SYSTEM     Checks for External Systems                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_AUTOXCHGINF     I DETERMINE_EXCHGINFO_AUTO      Determine material, quantity to be used for auto. mat. exchg.
IF_EX_BADI_PIC_PREPXCHDATA     I PREPARE_EXCHANGE_DATA         Prepare PO data, which are relevant for exchange            .
IF_EX_BADI_PLANT_ACTIVE        I CHECK_PLANT_ACTIVE            Check for Plant Activated                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_PLANT_AUTHORITY     I CHECK_PLANT_AUTHORITY         Check Authorization Object (WERKS/WB01)                     .
IF_EX_BADI_PLANT_AUTHORITY     I CHECK_PLANT_AUTHORITY2        Check Authorization Object (WERKS/WB02/06/07)               .
IF_EX_BADI_PLANT_AUTHORITY     I CHECK_PLANT_AUTHORITY3        Check Authorization Object (WERKS/WB03)                     .
IF_EX_BADI_PLANT_AUTHORITY     I CHECK_PLANT_AUTHORITY4        Check Authorization Object (WERKS/WB06)                     .
IF_EX_BADI_PRKNG_NO_UPDATE     I PARKING_NO_UPDATE             Method for Deactivating Update of Parked Documents          .
IF_EX_BADI_PVBE_UPDATE_APO     I SEND                          Send Data Changes                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_CDAT     I BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_CDAT          Makes It Possible to Use Additional Master Data             .
IF_EX_BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_EVAL     I BADI_EVALUATE_DATA            Further Reporting                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_LAY      I BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_SHOW          Outputs Data in Required Layout                             .
IF_EX_BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_RAT      I BADI_RAIDJP_TAX_RATES         Makes Various Depreciation Rates Available                  .
IF_EX_BADI_REXC_MS_CALC        I CALCULATE                     Recalculate                                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_REXC_MS_DATA        I AFTER_UPDATE_DB               After Saving Master Data                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_REXC_MS_DATA        I BEFORE_CORRDOC_MODIFY         Before Changing Adjustment Document                         .
IF_EX_BADI_REXC_MS_DATA        I BEFORE_UPDATE_DB              Before Saving Master Data                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_REXC_MS_DATA        I FILL_SELSCREEN                Fill Selection Screen (PAI)                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_RF_QUEUE            I QUEUE_DETERMINATION           RF Queue Determination                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_RULE_PAYMENTS       I PROCESS_RULE                  Processing of Payment Rule                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_RWRPLPRO_001        I EX_BADI_RWRPLPRO_001          Filter on replenishment combination for requirement planning.
IF_EX_BADI_RWRPLPRO_001        I EX_BADI_RWRPLPRO_002          Indicator for Generic Articles and Variants in RPLMAS       .
IF_EX_BADI_SAPLAD15_007        I EXIT_SAPLAD15_007             User exit to modify DLI                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I BILLING_DOC_CHANGE_REFERENCES Change References in Billing Document/Accounting            .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I BILLING_DOC_TYPE_SET          Specify Billing Type                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I CHECK_MAINSTEP_RESUBMIT       Check Restart of the Processing Step                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I CHECK_TO_CREATE_OI            Check Whether New Open Items Should Be Created              .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I DELIVERY_DETERMINE_2          Determine/Exchange Delivery                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I MATERIAL_EQUAL_DECIDE         Decision on Whether the Material Numbers are the Same       .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I OPEN_ITEM_DECIDE              Decision Whether Billing Document Is Open or Complete       .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I TRANSMITTED_DATA_MANIPULATE   Manipulating of Transmitted Data                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I TRNSM_AUTHORIZE_MULTIPLE      Authorization Check for Several Transmissions               .
IF_EX_BADI_SBWAP               I TRNSM_AUTHORIZE_SINGLE        Authorization Check for Single Transmission                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_ACCTG           I BEFORE_CHECK                  Account Assignment Determination Before Check               .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_CREATE          I SET_HEADER_DATA               Set Header Fields in a Shipment Cost Document               .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_CREATE          I SET_SHIPMENT_COST_TYPE        Specify the Shipment Cost Type                              .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_CREATE_CHCK     I CHECK_DOCUMENT_CREATE         Check whether the shipment cost document should be created  .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_PO_SELECT       I DETERMINATION_CHECK           Determination of Determination Rule                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_PO_SELECT       I PO_SELECT                     Determination of Purchase Order Item(s) for Standard Check  .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_PROCESS_CHK     I ITEM_DELETE_CHECK             Check whether shipment cost item can be deleted             .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_SAVE            I AT_SAVE                       Prepare New Objects When Saving Shipment Cost Documents     .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_SAVE            I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Save New Objects                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_SAVE            I CHECK_COMPLETE                Check Shipment Costs Document for Completeness Before Saving.
IF_EX_BADI_SCD_TRANSFER        I SET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Fill Reference Fields in Service Entry                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SCOCONF             I SCOCONF_AFTER_POSTING         Processing of Customer-Specific Data After Posting          .
IF_EX_BADI_SCOCONF             I SCOCONF_BEFORE_POSTING        Processing of Customer-Specific Data Before Posting         .
IF_EX_BADI_SCREEN_LOGIC_RT     I AREA_OF_VALIDITY_DIRECT       Customer-Spec. Control for Direct Screen Selection ValdArea .
IF_EX_BADI_SCREEN_LOGIC_RT     I CHANGE_SCREEN_SEQUENCE        Change Screen Sequence According to OMT3                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SCREEN_LOGIC_RT     I REDUCE_SCREEN_SELECTION       Subsequent Reduction of Possible Views                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I ACCOUNTING_DOC_HEADER         FI Interface: Header Line (Replacement for User Exit 001)   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I ACCOUNTING_HEAD_LINE          FI Interface (Debtor Line) (Replacement for User Exit 002)  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I ACCOUNTING_INTERFACE          AC Interface Transfer Tables (Replacement for Userexit 008) .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I ACCOUNTING_ITEM_LINE          AC Interface (G/L Acct Lines) (Replacement for Userexit 004).
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I ACCOUNTING_TAX_LINE           FI Interface (Tax Line) (Replacement for User Exit 006)     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I FICA_DOWNPAYMENT_CHARGE       FI-CA: Determine Down Payment Clearings                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I FICA_KUNNR_GET                FI-CA: Determine Tax Customers                              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I FICA_READ_HEADER_AWKEY        FI-CA: Read Document Header for Reference Billing Document  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ACCOUNTING       I FILL_ACCIT_DEB                FI Interface: Preparatory Table for the Debtor Line         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I ACC_DOC_PREPARE               Prepare Accounting Document                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I DOCUMENT_UPDATE_CHECK         Global Trade:  Add on  Save Data                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I INVOICE_CHANGE_POST           Change Billing Document Before Posting                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I INVOICE_DOCUMENT_ADD          Add Billing Documents                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I INVOICE_DOCUMENT_CHECK        Check Billing Documents                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I INVOICE_DOCUMENT_READ         Read Billing Documents                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I INVOICE_REFRESH               Refresh Tables                                              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Global Trade: Exchange Number                               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING          I PARTIAL_DPC_ACTIVATE          Partly Activate Down Payment Clearing                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I DPBP_SETTLED_DP_READ          Read Settled Down Payments for DP90 with Down Payments      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I FI_CA_DOWN_PAYMENTS_READ      Read Down Payments from FI-CA                               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I GET_INSERTED_ITEM             Global Trade: Flag Processed Data                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I HEADER_PRICING_COM            Pricing: Header Data                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I INVOICE_ACCOUNT_DETERM_HEADER Account Determination: Header Data                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I INVOICE_ACCOUNT_DETERM_ITEM   Account Determination: Item Data                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I INVOICE_CANCELLATION          Cancellation Check for FI-CA                                .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I ITEM_PRICING_COM              Pricing: Item Data                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I ITEM_SET_GSBER                Set Business Area for FI-CA                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I KUWEV_TXJCD_FILL              FI-CA: Adjust Tax Jurisdiction Code                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I PUBLISH_DOCUMENT              Global Trade: Publish Add On Data                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I VBRK_VBRP_DATA_TRANSFER       Data Transfer to Invoice Header and Invoice Item            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I VBRK_VBRP_DATA_TRANSFER_F     Data Transport Bet. Invoice Header and Invoice Item (Cancel).
IF_EX_BADI_SD_BILLING_ITEM     I VBRK_VBRP_FILL                Fill Billing Document Header and Items                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_COMMITMENT_UPDATE_DELVRY FSCM Commitment Update: Delivery                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_COMMITMENT_UPDATE_INVOICEFSCM Commitment Update: Billing Document                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_COMMITMENT_UPDATE_ORDER  FSCM Commitment Update: Order                               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_CREDIT_CHECK_DELVRY      FSCM Credit Check: Delivery                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_CREDIT_CHECK_ORDER       FSCM Credit Check: Order                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_CREDIT_CHECK_SM_ORDER    FSCM Credit Check: SM Document                              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_DISPLAY_CREDIT_MESSAGES  FSCM Credit Messages                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CM               I FSCM_GET_MASTER_DATA          FSCM Master Data                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_HEAD        I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_HEAD        I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_HEAD        I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Return Data from Subscreen to Invoice        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_HEAD        I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Billing Data to Subscreen                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_ITEM        I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_ITEM        I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_ITEM        I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Return Data from Subscreen to Invoice        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_CUST_ITEM        I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Billing Data to Subscreen                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DATE_UPDATE      I DATE_TO_DETERMINATION         Redetermination "Dates Until"                               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DMC_ORDER        I SD_DMC1                       Call Debit/Credit Linkage                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I ADD_PRECEDING_DOCUMENT        Add Preceding Document                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I ADD_SUBSEQUENT_DOCUMENT       Add Subsequent Document                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I CHANGE_TRANSACTION            Replacement for USEREXIT_CHANGE_TRANSACTION                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I DISPLAY_DOCUMENT              Display Document                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I DISPLAY_TRANSACTION           Replacement for USEREXIT_DISPLAY_TRANSACTION                .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I PREPARE_ORDER_FLOW_INFO       Prepare  RV_ORDER_FLOW_INFORMATION                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I READ_ACCOUNTING_DOCUMENT      Read Accounting Document                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DOCUMENTFLOW     I SET_STATUS                    Determine status                                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I EXIT_SD_SAPLV46H_001          Customer Function When Creating Item                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I EXIT_SD_SAPLV46H_002          Customer Function for Partner Changes                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I EXIT_SD_SAPLV46H_003          Customer Function when Creating/Changing Header             .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FCODE_PFPL_40                 Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0F_FCODE_PFPL_40                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FCODE_PKO4                    Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0F_FCODE_PK04                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FCODE_PKON                    Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0F_FCODE_PKON                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FILL_TFPLTS_1                 Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0F_FPLAN_AKTUALISIEREN_C         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FILL_TFPLTS_2                 Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0F_FPLAN_STATUS_AKTUALISI        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FILL_TFPLTS_3                 Fill Table TFPLTS in MV45AF0P_PREISFINDUNG_GESAMT           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I FUELLEN_VBAPKOM               Fill VBAPKOM in FV45PFAP_VBAP_FUELLEN_VBAPKOM               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I MODIFY_VBAKKOM                Modify VBAKKOM in LV46HF0H                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Order Data to Subscreen                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DPBP             I VKGRU_DETERMINE               Classification of Items                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_DSD_ORDER        I SD_DSD1                       Call Direct Store Delivery                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_EDI_DELSCHED     I IDOC_DATA_MODIFY              IDoc Manipulation in Release Receipt                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_FM_ASSIGN        I DATA_COPY_TO_COBL             Interface to copy VBAK and VBAP to COBL                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_GM               I GM_BILLING_STATUS_SET         Set Billing Status in Grants Management Table (GMIA)        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_MENUE_FM         I CALL_FCODE_FM                 Call Fund Management Documents (FM)                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_MENUE_TPM        I CALL_FCODE_TPM                Call Campaign Determination Analysis                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_PRICING_TUN      I PRICING_TUNING                Tuning for Pricing                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_REBATES          I BUILD_INDEX_WITH_PROCEDURE    Switch: Rebate Index (VBOX) Using Pricing Procedure         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_ROUTE            I ROUTE_DETERMINATION           Route Determination                                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I DELETE_DOCUMENT               Replacement for User Exit DELETE_DOCUMENT                   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I DOCUMENT_INIT                 Replacement for User Exit REFRESH_DOCUMENT (after saving)   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I READ_DOCUMENT                 Replacement for User Exit READ_DOCUMENT                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I SAVE_DOCUMENT                 Replacement for User Exit SAVE_DOCUMENT                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I SAVE_DOCUMENT_PREPARE         Replacement for User Exit SAVE_DOCUMENT_PREPARE             .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I SAVE_DOCUMENT_PREPARE_PART2   Call after Processing BELEG_ENDE                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES            I TRANSACTION_INIT              Unlike Document_Init at Start of New Transaction            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I CONFIGURATION_PROCESSING_1    Include fv45sfco_configuration_proces1                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I CONFIGURATION_PROCESSING_2    Include fv45sfco_configuration_proces1                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I CONFIGURATION_PROCESS_DATA    Include fv45sfco_configuration_proces2                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I CONFIGURATION_STRUCTURE_MATCH1Include fv45sfco_configuration_structu                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I CONFIGURATION_STRUCTURE_MATCH2Include fv45sfco_configuration_structu                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I KONFIGURATION_ANLEGEN         Include fv45pf0k_konfiguration_anlegen                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I VBAP_BEARBEITEN_ENDE          Include fv45pf0p_vbap_bearbeiten_ende                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I VBAP_MATNR_PRUEFEN            Include fv45pf0v_vbap-matnr_pruefen                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I VBEP_EDATU_EINGEBEN           Include fv45ef0v_vbep-edatu_eingeben                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I VBEP_WMENG_PRUEFEN            Include fv45ef0v_vbep-wmeng_pruefen                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I VBEP_WMENG_SETZEN             Include fv45ef0v_vbep-wmeng_setzen                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ADDON      I XVBAP_LOESCHEN_GRUPPE         Include fv45pfap_xvbap_loeschen_gruppe                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I DETERMINE_BUSINESS_AREA       Determination of Business Area                              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I DOCUMENT_FLOW_PRE             Document Flow Display: Add Preceding Document               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I DOCUMENT_FLOW_SUB             Document Flow Display: Add Subsequent Document              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I FLOW_LOGIC                    Manipulation of Next Screen Processing                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_CHANGE                 Fill the VBAK Structure (USEREXIT_MOVE_FIELD_TO_VBAK)       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_CHANGE2                Fill the VBAK Structure (USEREXIT_MOVE_FIELD_TO_VBAK)       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_CHECK                  Check of Header Data                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_COPY                   Copy of Header Data                                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_MAINTAIN_COM           Filling of Communication Structure VBAKKOM                  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I HEADER_STATUS                 Header Status Determination                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I INCOMPLETION_CHECK            Completeness Check                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I MAINTAIN_CUA                  Hiding and Showing Menu Options and Buttons                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I MAINTAIN_CUA_PART2            Do Not Hide Menu Entries (Particular to IS Beverage)        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I MAINTAIN_SCREEN               Hiding and Showing Screen Fields                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I PBO_SAPMV45A_4311             Manipulation of PBO SAPMV45A Screen 4311                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I PBO_SAPMV45A_4453             Manipulation of PBO SAPMV45A Screen 4453                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_BASIC      I VKONT_CHECK                   Check Contract Account                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHANGE                   Filling of Structure VBAP (USEREXIT_MOVE_FIELD_TO_VBAP)     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHANGE2                  Filling of Structure VBAP (USEREXIT_MOVE_FIELD_TO_VBAP)     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHANGE_BUSINESS_DATA     Filling of Structure VBKD  (USEREXIT_MOVE_FIELD_TO_VBKD)    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHECK                    Check of Item Data                                          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHECK_BUSINESS_DATA      Check Commercial Data                                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_CHECK_ZTERM              Check Terms of Payment                                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_COBL_COM_I               Fill Structure COBL (Userexit_Move_field_to_Cobl)           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_COPY                     Copy of Item Data                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_DELETE                   Item Deletion                                               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_FREEGOOD_COM_I           Fill Communication Structure for Free Goods                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_MAINTAIN_COM             Filling Communication Structure VBAPKOM                     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_PAYER_BUSINESS_DATA      Populate Commercial Data from Payer                         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_PREPARE                  Preparing Structure VBAP                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_PRICING_COM_H            Filling Communication Structure TKOMK                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_PRICING_COM_I            Filling Communication Structure TKOMP                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_PROCESS                  Processing of Structure VBAP                                .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_STATUS                   Item Status Determination                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_VKONT_VALUES             F4 Help for the Contract Account                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SALES_ITEM       I ITEM_ZTERM_VALUES             Alternative F4 Help for Terms of Payment                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SCHDL_AGREE      I CHECK_ABEFZ                   Check Sent Inbound Progress Count                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SCHDL_AGREE      I GET_QUANTITY_EDL              Determination: No. Consignment Iss by ESAs to be Considered .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SCHDL_AGREE      I GET_QUANTITY_LF               Determination: No. Deliveries to be Considered              .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SCHDL_AGREE      I GET_QUANTITY_MAIS             Determination: No. Foreign Orders to be Considered          .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_SCH_GETWAGFZ     I WAGFZ_FROM_S073               WAGFZ should be Read from Table S073                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_H       I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_H       I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_H       I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Subscreen Data back to Order                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_H       I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Order Data to Subscreen                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_I       I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_I       I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_I       I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Subscreen Data back to Order                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TAB_CUST_I       I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Order Data to Subscreen                      .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I MV45AF0B_CALL_S008            Call up Statistics for Structure S008 and Return Status     .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I MV45AFOB_BELEG_SICHERN        Call Up in Program MV45AF0B_BELEG_SICHERN                   .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RMCSS008_F0001_UPDATE         Call Up in Program RMCSS008 in Form F0001_UPDATE            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RMCSS008_F0002_UPDATE         Call Up in Program RMCSS008 in Form F0002_UPDATE            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RMCSS008_F0003_UPDATE         Call Up in Program RMCSS008 in Form F0003_UPDATE            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RMCSS008_F0010_UPDATE         Call Up in Program RMCSS008 in Form F0010_UPDATE            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RMCSS008_UPDATE_FROM_INT      Call Up in Program RMCSS008 in Form UPDATE_FROM_INT         .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RV_DOCUMENT_HEAD_STATUS_TEXTS Call Up in Function RV_DOCUMENT_HEAD_STATUS_TEXTS           .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I RV_INVOICE_DOCUMENT_ADD       Call Up in Function RV_INVOICE_DOCUMENT_ADD                 .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_TO_FM            I SET_STATUS_VBUK               Call Up in USEREXIT_SET_STATUS_VBUK, RV45PFZA               .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_UPDATE_PLVAL     I REQUIREMENT_CHECK             Check Condition for Update                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_V46H0001         I EXIT_SAPLV46H_001             Customer Function When Creating Item                        .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_V46H0001         I EXIT_SAPLV46H_002             Customer Function for Partner Changes                       .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_V46H0001         I EXIT_SAPLV46H_003             Customer Function when Creating/Changing Header             .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_VF48             I SET_TRANSACTION               Set Transaction and Parameter ID                            .
IF_EX_BADI_SD_VOFM             I ACTIVATE_MENU_ENTRIES         Activation of Menu Entries                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_SERIAL_IN_STO       I IS_ACTIVE                     Check whether S/N in STO functionality is active            .
IF_EX_BADI_SPEC_METADATA       I GET_DATA_FOR_DISPLAY          Returns Metadata Information for display                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SPEC_METADATA       I GET_DATA_FOR_MAPPING          Returns Metadata Information for mapping                    .
IF_EX_BADI_SPEC_METADATA       I GET_MACRO_NAME_FOR_DISPLAY    Returns macro name (for displaying metadata on office doc)  .
IF_EX_BADI_SPEC_METADATA       I GET_MACRO_NAME_FOR_MAPPING    Returns macro name (used for mapping metadata on office doc).
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_COBK                  Fill buffer T_BUF_CO and extract COBK                       .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_COEP                  Extract COEP using T_BUF_CO                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_KONV                  Extract KONV using T_KONV_KEY                               .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_MKPF                  Fill buffer T_BUF_MM and extract MKPF                       .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_MSEG                  Extract MSEG using T_BUF_MM                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_TTXY                  Extract TTXY using T_BUF_FI                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_VBRK                  Fill buffer T_BUF_BI and extract VBRK                       .
IF_EX_BADI_TXW_DATA_EXTRACTION I PROCESS_VBRP                  Extract VBRP using T_BUF_BI                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_UNFILLED_ORDERS     I METHOD_01                     Modify Qty and Obligation Correction Amount                 .
IF_EX_BADI_V55K_AII            I PROCESS_AII_DATA              Shipment/delivery IDOC: Process AII data                    .
IF_EX_BADI_V56K                I RAW_DATA_MANIPULATION         SHPMNT/DELVRY: Adjusting raw data before IDoc generation    .
IF_EX_BADI_V56K_AII            I PROCESS_AII_DATA              Shipment/delivery IDOC: Process AII data                    .
IF_EX_BADI_V56N                I OWN_DETERMINATION             Switch to Own Message Determination or Standard Procedure   .
IF_EX_BADI_VENDOR_CHAR01       I MAINTAIN_VENDOR_CHAR          Maintain Vendor Characteristic Values (Article-Dependent)   .
IF_EX_BADI_VENDOR_CHAR01       I POSTING_VENDOR_CHAR           Post Vendor Characteristic Values (Article-Dependent)       .
IF_EX_BADI_VENDOR_CHAR01       I UTILIZE_VENDOR_CHAR           Read article-specific characteristic values                 .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_001              Determination of AHD-Relevant MRP Types                     .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_002              Loading of AHD from Customer Data Sources                   .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_003              Place Filter on the AHD Articles to be Loaded               .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_004              Fill Customer Column in ALV Grid for AHD Display            .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_005              Determine Data to be Displayed and Popup Size for AHD Disp. .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_006              Fill Selection Table for Reading AHD from BW Using CL       .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_007              Correction of Replenishment Lead Time in Forecast           .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_008              Adjustment of BW Periods                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD                I EX_BADI_WAHD_009              Check Whether AHD Is Active                                 .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF_CONS_READ   Read Alternative Historical Time Series Instead of MVER     .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF_DISP_CHNG   Display/Change Alternative Historical Time Series           .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF_READ_WAHD   Read Alternative Historical Time Series                     .
IF_EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF           I EX_BADI_WAHD_INTF_RLT_SHIFT   Change Forecast Values After Forecast Calculation           .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_001              Customer Determination of Receiving Plants                  .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_002              Adjust Result to Standard Methods for Receiving Plants      .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_003              Customer Determination of Receiving Customers               .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_004              Adjust Result to Standard Methods for Receiving Customers   .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_005              Set references for the delivery relationship                .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_006              Customer Check of MRP Type                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_007              Customer Check of Source of Supply                          .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_008              Customer Check of Plant-Specific Material Status            .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_009              Check Manually Entered Recipients                           .
IF_EX_BADI_WDRD                I EX_BADI_WDRD_010              Customer-Specific Reading of Delivery Relationships         .
IF_EX_BADI_WFRM_SLS_RELEVANZ   I GET_SLS_RELEVANZ              Determination of SLS Relevance for a Collective PO Item     .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD1                I EX_BADI_WOD1_010              BAdI Data Changes After User Input                          .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD1                I EX_BADI_WOD1_011              BAdI For Message Control                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD1                I EX_BADI_WOD1_012              BAdI for Filtering Materials                                .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD1                I EX_BADI_WOD1_013              BAdI for Display Control of Messages for PO Posting         .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD2                I EX_BADI_WOD2_003              Order Status Determination                                  .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD2                I EX_BADI_WOD2_004              Determine Order Status - Details                            .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD2                I EX_BADI_WOD2_005              Manual status change in worklist?                           .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD3                I EX_BADI_WOD3_010              Select Data Table                                           .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD3                I EX_BADI_WOD3_020              Add To Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_BADI_WOD3                I EX_BADI_WOD3_030              Specify Exclude Functions                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_WPOCS_READ          I EX_READ_POS                   BAdI for Selection of Purchase Orders                       .
IF_EX_BADI_WPOCS_READ_POS      I EX_READ_POS                   BAdI for Selection of Purchase Orders                       .
IF_EX_BADI_WS_DOWNLOAD         I EXIT_SAPLGRAP_004             Character Conversion Exit                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI                I SET_DEFAULT_BATCH             Set Default Batch in IDoc Inbound                           .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_ADD            I FLAG_SALES_PRICE_READ         Check if SALES_PRICE Field in Outbound IDoc is to be Filled .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I BUILD_E1WVI03_OUT             Fill and Buffer Segment E1WVI03 With Units of Measure       .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I GET_SALES_PRICE               Get Sales Price If Stated In Customer Exit                  .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I INIT                          Initialization of Static Storage Areas                      .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I MOVE_E1WVI03_TO_EDIDD_ONE_ITEMSegment E1WVI03 From One Item In Table edidd moven          .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I PREFETCH_MARM_MARA_MVKE       Get Tables in Prefetch (Performance)                        .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_PDC            I READ_NEW_FIELDS               Read IDoc Category From Partner Profiles Outbound           .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I BUILD_E1WVI04_OUT             Build Internal Table with Long Texts for Sales Order        .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I CHECK_KDAUF_KDPOS             Check If Both Structures in KDAUF and KDPOS Are Equal       .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I CHECK_NEXT_ACTION             No Workitem Can Be Created When SOBKZ = 'E'                 .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I CHECK_SOBKZ                   Check If SOBKZ Is Permitted (Extended To Include 'E')       .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I FILL_NEW_FIELDS_OUT           IDoc Outbound: Determine Sales Order, Item and Short Text   .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I GET_FIELDS_FROM_INVPOS        Get Fields From Structure INVPOSITION                       .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I GET_NEW_FIELDS                Check And Adopt New Fields in Item Segment                  .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I INIT                          Initialization of Static Storage Areas                      .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I MOVE_E1WVI04_TO_EDIDD_ONE_ITEMSegment E1WVI04 from an Item in Table EDIDD MOVEN           .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I POST                          Posting Additional Data                                     .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I READ_P_T_EISEG_1              Read Entry from P_T_EISEG                                   .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I READ_P_T_ISEG_1               Read Entry from P_T_ISEG                                    .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I SORT_P_T_EISEG                Sorting for P_T_EISEG Extended to Include KDAUF KDPOS       .
IF_EX_BADI_WVFI_SOBKZ_E        I SORT_P_T_ISEG                 Sorting for P_T_ISEG Extended to Include KDAUF KDPOS        .
IF_EX_BADI_WVLB                I BADI_WVLB_001                 Filter for Released Purchase Orders                         .
IF_EX_BADI_WVLB                I BADI_WVLB_002                 Indic. for Information that Purchase Order Already Released .
IF_EX_BADI_XLO_CORR_ACTION     I CORRECTION_ACTION_1           Individual Correction Task 1                                .
IF_EX_BADI_XLO_CORR_ACTION     I CORRECTION_ACTION_2           Individual Correction Task 2                                .
IF_EX_BADI_XLO_CORR_ACTION     I CORRECTION_ACTION_3           Execute Mass Correction Task                                .
IF_EX_BADI_XLO_PLANT_DET       I PLANT_DETERMINE               Defines Plant and Logical System for Goods Recipient        .
IF_EX_BADI_XLO_STATUS_DET      I STATUS_DETERMINE              Defines Status of Delivery in Transit Process               .
IF_EX_BANKS_USAGE_LIST         I CHECK_BANKS                   Check Banks for Usage                                       .
IF_EX_BANK_PP_RUN_HISTORY      I HISTORIZE_INIT                Initialize History for Mass Run                             .
IF_EX_BANK_PP_RUN_HISTORY      I HISTORIZE_RUN                 Create History of Infos for Executing a Mass Run            .
IF_EX_BANK_PP_RUN_HISTORY      I HISTORIZE_RUNHD               Create History of Header Data of a Mass Run                 .
IF_EX_BANK_PP_RUN_HISTORY      I HISTORIZE_STATUSCHANGE        Create History of Status Transition within a Level          .
IF_EX_BANK_PP_RUN_HISTORY      I HISTORIZE_STEP                Create History of Level                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I CHANGE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I CHANGE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I CREATE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I CREATE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I DELETE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Delete                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I DELETE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Delete                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I GETDATA_EXIT1                 Exit 1 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2001          I GETDATA_EXIT2                 Exit 2 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_CHANGE_EXIT1          Exit 1 for BAPI Change Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_CHANGE_EXIT2          Exit 2 for BAPI Change Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_CREATE_EXIT1          Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_CREATE_EXIT2          Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_DELETE_EXIT1          Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_DELETE_EXIT2          Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity Element                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_GETDATA_EXIT1         Exit 1 for BAPI GetData Activity Element                    .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACTELEM_GETDATA_EXIT2         Exit 2 for BAPI GetData Activity Element                    .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_CHANGE_EXIT1              Exit 1 for BAPI Change Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_CHANGE_EXIT2              Exit 2 for BAPI Change Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_CREATE_EXIT1              Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_CREATE_EXIT2              Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_DELETE_EXIT1              Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_DELETE_EXIT2              Exit 1 for BAPI Create Activity                             .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_GETDATA_EXIT1             Exit 1 for BAPI GetData Activity                            .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I ACT_GETDATA_EXIT2             Exit 2 for BAPI GetData Activity                            .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I CHANGE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I CHANGE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I CREATE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I CREATE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I DELETE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I DELETE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I GETDATA_EXIT1                 Exit 1 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2002          I GETDATA_EXIT2                 Exit 2 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I CHANGE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I CHANGE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Change                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I CREATE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I CREATE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I DELETE_EXIT1                  Exit 1 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I DELETE_EXIT2                  Exit 2 for BAPI Create                                      .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I GETDATA_EXIT1                 Exit 1 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_BUS2054          I GETDATA_EXIT2                 Exit 2 for BAPI GetData                                     .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_SCUSTOMER        I CREATEFROMDATA_EXIT1          Exit1 for BAPI CreateFromData                               .
IF_EX_BAPIEXT_SCUSTOMER        I CREATEFROMDATA_EXIT2          Exit2 for BAPI CreateFromData                               .
IF_EX_BAPIOBDLVSPLITDEC        I INPUT_EXTENSION               Extension for BAPI Acess (Asynchronous IDoc Inbound Proc.)  .
IF_EX_BAPIOBDLVSPLITDEC        I OUTPUT_EXTENSION              Extension for Asynchronous IDoc Outbound Processing         .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I CHANGE_IN                     Exit for grant master Change - before update                .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I CHANGE_OUT                    Exit for grant master Change - after update                 .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I CREATE_IN                     Exit for grant master Create - before update                .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I CREATE_OUT                    Exit for grant master Create - after update                 .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I GETDETAIL_IN                  Exit for grant master Getdetail -input                      .
IF_EX_BAPI_0035                I GETDETAIL_OUT                 Exit for grant master Getdetail -output                     .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I CREATE_IN                     Exit for entry document Create - before update              .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I CREATE_OUT                    Exit for entry document Create - after update               .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I GETDETAIL_IN                  Exit for entry document Get Detail - Input                  .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I GETDETAIL_OUT                 Exit for entry document Get Detail - Output                 .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I GETLIST_IN                    Exit for entry document Get List - Input                    .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I GETLIST_OUT                   Exit for entry document Get List - Output                   .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I REVERSE_IN                    Exit for entry document Reverse - before update             .
IF_EX_BAPI_0036                I REVERSE_OUT                   Exit for entry document Reverse - after update              .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I CHANGE_IN                     Exit for funded program Change - before update              .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I CHANGE_OUT                    Exit for funded program Change - after update               .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I CREATE_IN                     Exit for funded program Create - before update              .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I CREATE_OUT                    Exit for funded program Create - after update               .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I DELETE_IN                     Exit for funded program Delete - before update              .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I DELETE_OUT                    Exit for funded program Delete - after update               .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I GETDETAIL_IN                  Exit for funded program GetDetail - before update           .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I GETDETAIL_OUT                 Exit for funded program GetDetail - after update            .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I GETLIST_IN                    Exit for funded program GetList - before update             .
IF_EX_BAPI_0038                I GETLIST_OUT                   Exit for funded program GetList  - after update             .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I CREATE_IN                     Cust. enhancement for entry document Create - before update .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I CREATE_OUT                    Cust. enhancement for entry document Create - After update  .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I GETDETAIL_IN                  Customer enhancement for entry document Get detail - Input  .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I GETDETAIL_OUT                 Customer enhancement for entry document Get detail - Ouput  .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I GETLIST_IN                    Customer enhancement for entry document Get list - Input    .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I GETLIST_OUT                   Customer enhancement for entry document Get list - Output   .
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I REVERSE_IN                    Cust. enhancement for entry document Reverse - Before update.
IF_EX_BAPI_0050                I REVERSE_OUT                   Cust. enhancement for entry document Reverse - After update .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_DELETE      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_DELETE      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Check of Import Parameters from the BAPI Interface          .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_READ        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_READ        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Check of Import Parameters from the BAPI Interface          .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_WRITE       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_BAPI_FSBP_TC_WRITE       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Check of Import Parameters from the BAPI Interface          .
IF_EX_BATCH_DATA_CHANGE_INT    I CHANGE_BATCH_DATA             Change Batch Master Record                                  .
IF_EX_BATCH_DEFAULT_STATUS_INT I SET_DEFAULT_STATUS            Determining the initial status of a batch                   .
IF_EX_BATCH_MASTER             I CHECK_CLASSIF_BEFORE_SAVE     Batch Classification Check When Saving                      .
IF_EX_BATCH_MASTER             I CHECK_DATA_BEFORE_SAVE        Check Batch Data at Save                                    .
IF_EX_BATCH_MASTER             I SINGLE_FIELD_CONTROL          Field Selection Control                                     .
IF_EX_BBP_BADI_EXTREQ_OUT      I BBP_GROUPING_MAPPING          Group Requirements and Carry Out Field Mapping              .
IF_EX_BBP_CTR                  I MODIFY_DATA_CTR               Change Contract Data                                        .
IF_EX_BBP_CTR                  I MODIFY_IDOC_DATA_CND          Change Condition Data in IDOC                               .
IF_EX_BBP_CTR                  I MODIFY_IDOC_DATA_CTR          Change Contract Data in IDOC                                .
IF_EX_BBP_CTR_INIT_UP_PI       I MODIFY_DATA                   Change the R/3 Contract Data                                .
IF_EX_BBP_MAP_VMDATA_CF        I MAP_DATA                      Map Customer Fields for Vendor Master Data                  .
IF_EX_BBP_MAP_VMDATA_IBU       I MAP_DATA                      Map Customer Fields for Vendor Master Data                  .
IF_EX_BBP_NOTAFISCAL           I BEFORE_CREATE                 Before call to method CreateFromData of nota fiscal BAPI    .
IF_EX_BBP_PO_INBOUND_BADI      I BBP_MAP_AFTER_BAPI            Mapping Change after BAPI Call-Up                           .
IF_EX_BBP_PO_INBOUND_BADI      I BBP_MAP_BEFORE_BAPI           Mapping Change before BAPI Call-Up                          .
IF_EX_BBY_USED_FILL_BADI       I GET_ADDITIONAL_STORES         Delivers Additional Stores for Structuring the History Table.
IF_EX_BC_IMPLEMENTATION        I GET_BC_IMPLEMENTATION_AGENT   Name of Class Agent of Implementing Class                   .
IF_EX_BDCP_BEFORE_WRITE        I FILTER_BDCPV_BEFORE_WRITE     Filterin of Change Pointers Before Writing to Database      .
IF_EX_BDT_GUI                  I CHANGE                        Change Texts/Icons for the Additional GUI Function          .
IF_EX_BF_STOCKDET              I CHANGE_ITEM_TABLE             Change the Item Table                                       .
IF_EX_BF_STOCKDET              I DETERMINE_RULES               Change Rule                                                 .
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I MASTER_ADD_DATA_FILL_IN       Add Additional Data to Selection Result: Batches            .
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I MASTER_ADD_DATA_SELECT        Select Additional Data for Selection Result: Batches        .
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I MASTER_COLUMNS_ADD            Add Columns for Additional Data for Selection Result:Batches.
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I STOCK_ADD_DATA_FILL_IN        Add Additional Data to Selection Result: Stock              .
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I STOCK_ADD_DATA_SELECT         Select Additional Data for Selection Result: Stock          .
IF_EX_BIC_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I STOCK_COLUMNS_ADD             Add Columns for Additional Data for Selection Result: Stock .
IF_EX_BIC_FOLLOW_UP_ACTION     I ADD_MSG_TO_LOG                Adds a message to the application log                       .
IF_EX_BIC_FOLLOW_UP_ACTION     I BUILD_LOG_PROFILE             Constructs the field catalog for the application log        .
IF_EX_BIC_FOLLOW_UP_ACTION     I PASS_BATCHES_FOR_ACTION       Transfers selected batches to follow-up actions             .
IF_EX_BIC_FOLLOW_UP_ACTION     I SAVE_LOG_TO_DB                Saves the application log to the database                   .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I ACTION_WITH_INFO_OBJECT       Executes an action for a customer-specific info object      .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I CHECK_FOR_OBLIGATORY_INPUT    Check on Mandatory Entries for "Execute Selection"          .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I CHECK_SUBSCREEN_FOR_INPUT     Checks free selection tab pages for user entries            .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I DEFINE_SUBSCREEN              Definition of a free selection tab page                     .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I ENRICH_MASTER_RESULT          More details for the 'Selection Results Batches'            .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I GET_SELID_FOR_ENHANCEMENT     Procures ID of Selection Enhancement from Customizing       .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I PRESELECT_BATCHES             Customer-specific preselection of batches                   .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I REFINE_SELECTION_RESULT       Deletes entries from the 'Selection Results Batches'        .
IF_EX_BIC_SELECTION            I RESET_SUBSCREEN               Resets the selection criteria for the selection tab page    .
IF_EX_BIZC_CONTENTPROVIDER     I GET_AUTHORING_SERVICE         Factory for Authoring Service                               .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CHANGE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CHANGE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CHANGE         I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CLOSE          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CLOSE          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CLOSE          I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CREATE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Verarbeitung der Eingangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CREATE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Verarbeitung der Ausgangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CREATE         I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Auswertung der Eingangsparameter in BAPI-Format             .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CR_EASY        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CR_EASY        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_CR_EASY        I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVAMNT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVAMNT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVAMNT     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVMNT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVMNT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_AVMNT      I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_BAL        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_BAL        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_BAL        I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_DETAIL     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_DETAIL     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_DETAIL     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_ITEMS      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Verarbeitung der Eingangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_ITEMS      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Verarbeitung der Ausgangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_ITEMS      I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Auswertung der Eingangsparameter in BAPI-Format             .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_GET_LIST       I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_ITEM_GETL      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_ITEM_GETL      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_ACCNT_ITEM_GETL      I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_BALNOT_CREATE_S      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Verarbeitung der Eingangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_BALNOT_CREATE_S      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Verarbeitung der Ausgangsparameter im API-Format            .
IF_EX_BKK_BALNOT_CREATE_S      I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Auswertung der Eingangsparameter in BAPI-Format             .
IF_EX_BKK_BUPA_GET_TC          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_BUPA_GET_TC          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_BUPA_GET_TC          I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CHANGE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CHANGE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CHANGE         I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CREATE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CREATE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_CREATE         I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_DELETE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_DELETE         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_DELETE         I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_DETAIL     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_DETAIL     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_DETAIL     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_FORWD_GET_LIST       I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_PRODUCT_GET_DET      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_PRODUCT_GET_DET      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_PRODUCT_GET_DET      I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CHANGE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CHANGE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CHANGE     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_CREATE     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_DELETE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_DELETE     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_DISP       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_DISP       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_DISP       I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETDET     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETDET     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETDET     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETLST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETLST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STAND_ORD_GETLST     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STORDFDMOD_GET       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STORDFDMOD_GET       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STORDFDMOD_GET       I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BKK_STORFDMOD_GETDET     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Output Parameter in API format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STORFDMOD_GETDET     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Evaluation of Input Parameter in BAPI format                .
IF_EX_BKK_STORFDMOD_GETDET     I VALIDATEEXTENSION             Processing of Input Parameter in API format                 .
IF_EX_BLOCKING_PLANT_E         I CHANGE_PLANT_BLOCKING         Change Blocking Procedure for Plant                         .
IF_EX_BOLETO_BARCODE           I CONVERT                       Validate Data and Convert Barcode                           .
IF_EX_BOLETO_BARCODE           I REVERT                        Reconvert Barcode to Original                               .
IF_EX_BOLETO_BARCODE           I VALIDATE                      Validate Barcode                                            .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ACCOUNT_DETERMINATION         Deactivate G/L Account Determination in BOM Maintenance     .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ALE_IDENTIFY_BY_GUID_INBOUND  ALE: GUID ID Active for Inbound Processing                  .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ALE_IDENTIFY_BY_GUID_OUTBOUND ALE: GUID for Writing Header/Item ID to IDoc                .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ALE_IGNORE_INIT_POSNR         ALE Inbound Processing: Initial POSNR on Restart            .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ALE_POSNR_SET                 ALE Inbound Processing: Item Number Assigned Automatically  .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I BOM_COMMIT_CONTROL            Commit Control for BOM Maintenance                          .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I CHANGE_POINTERS_CONTROL       Control the change pointer for BOM list IDocs               .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I CHECK_PLANT_AUTH_IN_GROUP_BOM Authorization check C_STUE_WRK in group BOM list            .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I DOCUMENT_DATA_COMPLETE        Type of Enhancement to Document Key                         .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ITEM_CREATION_NO_ECN          Items Created Without Change Number                         .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I ITEM_SORT_AFTER_INSERT        Automatically Sort Items After Creating an Item             .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I KNOWLEDGE_DATE_SET            Define valid-from date on calling object dependencies       .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I NO_PARAMETER_POPUP_IN_COPY    No manual parameter valuation during template copying       .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I RCSALOTR_DATUV                RCSALOTR: Override Default Explosion Date VBAP-STDAT        .
IF_EX_BOM_EXIT                 I START_SCREEN_CHECK            Data of start screen will be made available                 .
IF_EX_BOM_IPPE                 I CHECK_MATERIAL                Material check                                              .
IF_EX_BOM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_AT_SAVE                When daving in dialog                                       .
IF_EX_BOM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Before calling up update                                    .
IF_EX_BOM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_IN_UPDATE              In the update                                               .
IF_EX_BORES_DETERMINATION      I BORES_SOURCE_DETERMINATION    PO Determination                                            .
IF_EX_BORGR_DIALOG             I GET_CLASSNAME_DIALOG_OWNER    Own Class Name When Basic Object Is Created                 .
IF_EX_BORGR_DIALOG             I GET_CLASSNAME_DOC_OBJECT      Own Class Name When Doc Objects Are Created                 .
IF_EX_BORGR_DIALOG             I GET_CLASSNAME_TNODE_OBJECT    Own Class Name When Node Objects Are Created                .
IF_EX_BORGR_POD_DETERMINATION  I BORGR_POD_DETERMINATION       Automatic PO Determination                                  .
IF_EX_BORGR_REGISTRATION       I FUNCTION_AFTER_REGISTRATION   Own Functions After Posting the Registration                .
IF_EX_BORTE_TRX_CHECK_POS      I IF_TRX_STEP1                  General Check of Route-Relevant Data                        .
IF_EX_BORTE_TRX_CHECK_POS      I IF_TRX_STEP2                  Determine Route and Trackable Points                        .
IF_EX_BORTE_TRX_CHECK_POS      I IF_TRX_STEP3                  Scheduling                                                  .
IF_EX_BPREL_PROXY_INBOUND      I CHANGE_BPREL_IN               Adapt BP_Relations                                          .
IF_EX_BPREP_RETRACTION_BCS     I GET_RETRACTION_DATA           Retraction of Data for the BCS for FM                       .
IF_EX_BPREP_RETRACTION_BUD     I GET_RETRACTION_DATA           Retraction of Data for FM Budget                            .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP001             I BPTIME_BP001_GET              Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP001                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP001             I BPTIME_BP001_SET              Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP001                    .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP011             I BPTIME_BP011_API_GET          Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP011 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP011             I BPTIME_BP011_API_SET          Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP011 (for API)          .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP011             I BPTIME_BP011_GET              Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP011                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP011             I BPTIME_BP011_SET              Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP011                    .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP021             I BPTIME_BP021_API_GET          Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP021 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP021             I BPTIME_BP021_API_SET          Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP021 (for API)          .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP021             I BPTIME_BP021_GET              Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP021                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP021             I BPTIME_BP021_SET              Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP021                    .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1010            I BPTIME_BP1010_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1010                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1010            I BPTIME_BP1010_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1010                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1012            I BPTIME_BP1012_API_GET         Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1012 (for API)        .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1012            I BPTIME_BP1012_API_SET         Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1012 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1012            I BPTIME_BP1012_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1012                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1012            I BPTIME_BP1012_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1012                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1013            I BPTIME_BP1013_API_GET         Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1013 (for API)        .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1013            I BPTIME_BP1013_API_SET         Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1013 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1013            I BPTIME_BP1013_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1013                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1013            I BPTIME_BP1013_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1013                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1030            I BPTIME_BP1030_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP1030                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP1030            I BPTIME_BP1030_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP1030                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3010            I BPTIME_BP3010_API_GET         Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP3010 (for API)        .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3010            I BPTIME_BP3010_API_SET         Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP3010 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3010            I BPTIME_BP3010_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP3010                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3010            I BPTIME_BP3010_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP3010                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3100            I BPTIME_BP3100_API_GET         Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP3100 (for API)        .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3100            I BPTIME_BP3100_API_SET         Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP3100 (for API)         .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3100            I BPTIME_BP3100_GET             Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BP3100                  .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BP3100            I BPTIME_BP3100_SET             Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BP3100                   .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT021_FS         I BPTIME_BUT021_FS_API_GET      Reads from the Versio Table BPTIME_BUT021_FS (for API)      .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT021_FS         I BPTIME_BUT021_FS_API_SET      Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BUT021_FS (for API)      .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT021_FS         I BPTIME_BUT021_FS_GET          Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BUT021_FS               .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT021_FS         I BPTIME_BUT021_FS_SET          Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BUT021_FS                .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT0BANK          I BPTIME_BUT0BANK_GET           Reads from the Version Table BPTIME_BUT0BANK                .
IF_EX_BPTIME_BUT0BANK          I BPTIME_BUT0BANK_SET           Writes to the Version Table BPTIME_BUTOBANK                 .
IF_EX_BRF_ACTION               I PROCESS                       Executing Method                                            .
IF_EX_BRF_EXPRESSION           I PROCESS                       Executing Method                                            .
IF_EX_BR_VALUT_DATE            I GET_VALUT_DATE                Define user specific valut date                             .
IF_EX_BSFC_POLICY              I GET_POLICY                    Get Policy Information                                      .
IF_EX_BSP_WD_APPL_WB           I GET_APPL_MODEL_CLASSNAME      Name of the Application Model Class                         .
IF_EX_BSP_WD_APPL_WB           I GET_CUST_CLASSNAME_PROPOSAL   Name Proposal for Customer-Defined Derivation Class         .
IF_EX_BUAVC_CHECK_RESTRICT     I AVC_SET_RESTRICTIONS          AVC Set Restriction                                         .
IF_EX_BUAVC_DB_ACCESS          I UPDATE_FISL                   Enhance the Update of the FI-SL Ledger Tables               .
IF_EX_BUBAS_STRAT_ENV          I CHECK_DELETE_ALLOWED          Check whether the environment can be deleted                .
IF_EX_BUBAS_STRAT_ENV          I CHECK_NEW_ENV                 Check the name of a new environment of derivation strategy  .
IF_EX_BUBAS_STRAT_ENV          I MODIFY_MSG_MISSING_ENV        Redefine message for missing derivation strategy            .
IF_EX_BUHI_EXIT_CHECK          I BUHI_BPNODE_ASSIGN            Method called to check BP-Node assignment.                  .
IF_EX_BUHI_EXIT_CHECK          I BUHI_BPNODE_DE_ASSIGN         Method called to check BP-Node de-assignment.               .
IF_EX_BUILDUPSHOPNAME_E        I SETSHOPNAME                   Set Up and Check Shop Name                                  .
IF_EX_BUILD_SHOP_NAME_E        I BUILD_SHOPNAME                Custom Assignment of Shop Name (Category, Template)         .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADDR_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADDR_EXPORT         I ADDR_DATA_EXPORT              Exports Address References and Address Usages               .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADDR_IMPORT         I ADDR_COMPLETE_IMPORT          Imports the Complete Address Data                           .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADDR_IMPORT         I ADDR_DATA_IMPORT              Imports Address References and Usages                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADDR_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Addresses Created or Changed                                .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADRREL_EXPORT       I ADRREL_DATA_EXPORT            Export of Address References for Relationships              .
IF_EX_BUPA_ADRREL_IMPORT       I ADRREL_DATA_IMPORT            Imports Address Data for BP Relationships                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_APPLI_CHECK         I APPLI_CHECK                   Change Activity Status of BDT Applications                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_AUGRP               I GET_AUGRP                     Determination of the Authorization Groups Assigned to a User.
IF_EX_BUPA_BANK_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_BANK_EXPORT         I BANK_DATA_EXPORT              Exports Bank Data of a Business Partner                     .
IF_EX_BUPA_BANK_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Bank Data Created or Changed                                .
IF_EX_BUPA_BW                  I SUPPRESS_BW_DELTA_QUEUE_UPDATEQuery Whether or Not To Supress Delta Update for DataSource .
IF_EX_BUPA_CARDS_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Payment Card Data Created or Changed                        .
IF_EX_BUPA_CCARD_EXPORT        I CCARD_DATA_EXPORT             Exports Payment Card Data                                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_CCARD_IMPORT        I CCARD_DATA_IMPORT             Imports Payment Card Data to the BP                         .
IF_EX_BUPA_CENTR_CI_CHECK      I CENTRAL_CI_DATA_CHECK         Checks Data of the CI Include                               .
IF_EX_BUPA_CONTPREL_EXPORT     I CONTPREL_DATA_EXPORT          Exports Detailed Data to the Contact Person Relationships   .
IF_EX_BUPA_CONTPREL_IMPORT     I CONTPREL_DATA_IMPORT          Imports Detailed Data for Contact Person Relationship       .
IF_EX_BUPA_DA_PREPARE          I SELECT_DATA                   Restriction of the Selected Data                            .
IF_EX_BUPA_DELETION            I RELOAD_DONE                   Exit Following Successful Reload                            .
IF_EX_BUPA_DELETION            I VERIFICATION_DONE             Exit after Successful Check (ARCH1/DELE1)                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_DO_NOT_CALL         I MAINTAIN_FLG_NOUSE            Method for Not Setting the FLG_NOUSE Flags in ADR2          .
IF_EX_BUPA_EXTINCL_CHECK       I BUPA_EXTINCL_DATA_CHECK       BP: Checks Data of the BUT000 Extension Includes            .
IF_EX_BUPA_FRG0060_UPDATE      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Appointments Created or Changed                             .
IF_EX_BUPA_FURTHER_CHECKS      I CHECK_CENTRAL                 Check of Central Part                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_GENERAL_EXPORT      I GENERAL_DATA_EXPORT           Exports General BP Data                                     .
IF_EX_BUPA_GENERAL_IMPORT      I GENERAL_DATA_IMPORT           Imports General Data of the SAP BP                          .
IF_EX_BUPA_GENERAL_UPDATE      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          General Data Created or Changed                             .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_BW        I CHANGE_BEFORE_SELECTION       Changes to Interval Table Before Selection in SAP BW        .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I CLEAR                         Removes Condition Records from Working Set                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I CLEAR_NODE_AND_TIME           Deletes the Selected Node                                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I CLOSE                         Control in Pre-Init Status Without Saving                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I CREATE_WORK_AREA              Initialization of Condition Maintainance                    .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I DISPLAY_CONDITION             Update Condition Maintenance (Provides OK)                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I GET_ROOT_OF_SUBTREE           Returns the Root Node of the Subtree                        .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I GET_TEXT_FOR_NODE             Returns New Search Term and Description                     .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I HAS_SAME_AREA                 Nodes Have the Same Sales Area?                             .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I IS_CONDITION_AVAILABLE        Implementation Is Available                                 .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I IS_TREE_DOWNLOADED            Returns, Whether Tree Was Downloaded from ERP               .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I IS_TYPE_DOWNLOADED            Returns, Whether Hierarchy Category Comes from R3           .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I SAVE                          Saves Working Set in DB                                     .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I SET_CONTEXT_DATA              Sets New Context Data                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Set Edit Mode                                               .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I SET_NODE_AND_TIME             Note Nodes in Locator                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I SPECIFY_APPEARANCE            Set Up Appearance of ALVs                                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_CRM       I XCHANGE                       Checks Whether Something Has Changed                        .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_UPD       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Change Before Saving                                        .
IF_EX_BUPA_HIERARCHY_UPD       I PUBLISH_EXT_INTERFACE         Publishing of the Complex Structure                         .
IF_EX_BUPA_IDENT_CHECK         I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_IDENT_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Identification Numbers Created or Changed                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_INDSEC_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_INDSEC_EXPORT       I INDSEC_DATA_EXPORT            Exports Industry Data                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_INDSEC_IMPORT       I INDSEC_DATA_IMPORT            Imports Industry Data                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_INDSEC_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Industry Code Data Created or Changed                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_INITIAL_SCREEN      I INITIAL_SCREEN                Display the initial screen of  BP creation                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_INTCOMP_EXPORT      I INTCOMPREL_DATA_EXPORT        Exports Detailed Data for Rel. Type Investment in Firm      .
IF_EX_BUPA_INTCOMP_IMPORT      I INTCOMPREL_DATA_IMPORT        Imports Detailed Data for Rel.-Type Investment in Firm      .
IF_EX_BUPA_LOCK                I LOCK                          Set Locks                                                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_LOCK                I UNLOCK                        Reset Lock                                                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_MASK_LIST_ITEM      I GET_FIELDMASK_DETAILS         Get the de-personalized settings of the field               .
IF_EX_BUPA_NUMBER_GROUP        I VALID_NUMBER_GROUP            Presets the value number grouping field.                    .
IF_EX_BUPA_OUTBOUND            I AFTER_OUTBOUND                Is Called After Complext Structure Is Sent                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_PARTNER_CATEGORY    I ALLOW_CATEGORY                Determine  partner categories allowed for non update roles  .
IF_EX_BUPA_PCARD_CHECK         I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_RELATSHP_UPDATE     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Relationships Created or Changed                            .
IF_EX_BUPA_RELSHP_EXPORT       I RELSHP_DATA_EXPORT            Exports Relationship Data - Management Table                .
IF_EX_BUPA_RELSHP_IMPORT       I RELSHP_DATA_IMPORT            Imports Relationship Data                                   .
IF_EX_BUPA_ROLES_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Role Data Created or Changed                                .
IF_EX_BUPA_ROLE_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_BUPA_ROLE_EXPORT         I ROLE_DATA_EXPORT              Exports Role Information for the SAP Business Partner       .
IF_EX_BUPA_ROLE_IMPORT         I ROLE_DATA_IMPORT              Imports Role Data                                           .
IF_EX_BUPA_SAVE_CONTROL        I SAVE_LATER                    Save to be carried out later                                .
IF_EX_BUPA_SAVE_CONTROL        I SAVE_NOW                      Save to be carried out now                                  .
IF_EX_BUPA_SHLP_CONTROL        I FILTER_INCL_SHLP              Controls Elementary Search Helps in Collective Search Helps .
IF_EX_BUPA_STATUS              I ON_SAVE                       After Data Backup                                           .
IF_EX_BUPA_TAX_UPDATE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Tax Numbers Created or Changed                              .
IF_EX_BUPA_TEMPL_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Template Assignments Created or Changed                     .
IF_EX_BUPA_UNAME_ORG_BW        I CHANGE_RELEVANT_ROLES         Setting Roles for User/Org. Unit                            .
IF_EX_BUPA_UNAME_ORG_BW        I SET_SOURCE                    Set Table Used as Basis (BUT000 or BUT100)                  .
IF_EX_BUPR_CHNG_DATE_APPL      I CHANGE_VALIDITY_APPL          Method to process when BPRELvalidity dates are changed.     .
IF_EX_BUPR_ENQUEUE_TEST        I BPR_ENQUEUE                   If Relationship of BP Is Locked                             .
IF_EX_BUPR_FILTER_RELSHP       I FILTER_RELSHP                 Filtering of the Total Amount of the Relationships          .
IF_EX_BUPR_FILTER_RELSHP_2     I FILTER_RELSHP                 Filtering of Relationships for Display in the GUI           .
IF_EX_BUPR_FILTER_RELTYP       I FILTER_RELTYP                 Filter Relationship Types                                   .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_CHNG      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Mapping Enhancement Data to Direct Input Format             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_CHNG      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Enhancement of Data Processing and ExtensionOut             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_CHNG      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Check Inbound Parameters from BAPI Interface                .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_DEL       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Enhancement of Data Processing and ExtensionOut             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_GET       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Enhancement of Data Processing and ExtensionOut             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_INS       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Mapping Enhancement Data to Direct Input Format             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_INS       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Enhancement of Data Processing and ExtensionOut             .
IF_EX_BUPR_GEN_SHARE_INS       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Check Inbound Parameters from BAPI Interface                .
IF_EX_BUPR_LOCK                I LOCK                          Set Locks                                                   .
IF_EX_BUPR_LOCK                I UNLOCK                        Reset Lock                                                  .
IF_EX_BUPR_RELSHP_OVR_EXT      I GET_OVERVIEW_EXTENSION        Read Extensions of Relationship Overview                    .
IF_EX_BUS10507_CONF_DATA       I CONF_DATA_GET                 Provision of the Posted Backflushes                         .
IF_EX_BUS_LOCA_HIDE_SEARCH     I HIDE_SEARCH_IDS               Hiding of Search IDs                                        .
IF_EX_BUS_LOCA_HIDE_SEARCH     I HIDE_SEARCH_TYPES             Hiding of Search Types                                      .
IF_EX_BUTP_TP_CHANGE           I CHANGE                        Change trading partner                                      .
IF_EX_BUTP_TP_CREATE           I CREATE                        Create trading partner                                      .
IF_EX_BUTP_TP_DELETE           I DELETE                        Delete trading partner                                      .
IF_EX_BUTX_FRG0010_UPDATE      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Partner Function Exclusion List Changed                     .
IF_EX_BW_SCHEDULER             I USER_EXIT                     Fill Variables                                              .
IF_EX_CACL_CHANGENO_NEEDED     I CHANGENO_NEEDED               Check Whether a Change Number is Required                   .
IF_EX_CACL_CHARACTER_INPUT     I SET_CHARACTER_INPUT           Sets the Ready-For-Input Status of a Characteristic         .
IF_EX_CACL_CHECK_ECN           I CHECK_CHANGENO                Check Whether a Change Number is Required                   .
IF_EX_CACL_CHR_CHECKS          I CHECK_USAGE                   Check Use of Characteristics                                .
IF_EX_CACL_CHR_CHECKS          I DELETE                        Deletion Allowed?                                           .
IF_EX_CACL_CHR_CHECKS          I RENAME                        Renaming Allowed?                                           .
IF_EX_CACL_MAIN01              I SET_MANDATORY_FIELDS          Set Required Characteristics                                .
IF_EX_CACL_NAMESPACE           I GET_ATINN_FROM_NAMESPACE      Gets the Internal Characteristic Number from the Namespace  .
IF_EX_CACL_NAMESPACE           I GET_CLINT_FROM_NAMESPACE      Gets the Internal Class Number from the Namespace           .
IF_EX_CACL_VALUE_CHANGE        I MODIFY_INPUT                  Change/Check User Input Before Syntax Check                 .
IF_EX_CACS41_ELTDOC            I CHECK_TRANSFER_DOCUMENT       Check of Transfer Document                                  .
IF_EX_CACS41_ELTDOC            I GET_DUE_PRIOR_TO_MATURITY     Disbursable Entitlement Calculation on Payout               .
IF_EX_CACS41_ELTDOC            I SET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_HEAD      Set Customer Fields (Commission Case Header)                .
IF_EX_CACS41_ELTDOC            I SET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_REM       Set Customer Fields (Remuneration Line)                     .
IF_EX_CACS_COND_VERSIONING     I CACS_VERSIONING_SELECT        Select for CACS Version Management                          .
IF_EX_CACS_COND_VERSIONING     I CACS_VERSIONING_SET_COL_ATTR  Setting Column Attrib. in Fast Data Entry for CACS Vers.Mgmt.
IF_EX_CACS_COND_VERSIONING     I CACS_VERSIONING_UPDATE        Update for CACS Version Management                          .
IF_EX_CACS_ELT_DOCUMENT        I CHECK_TRANSFER_DOCUMENT       Check of Transfer Document                                  .
IF_EX_CACS_ELT_DOCUMENT        I GET_DUE_PRIOR_TO_MATURITY     Disbursable Entitlement Calculation on Payout               .
IF_EX_CACS_ELT_DOCUMENT        I SET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_HEAD      Set Customer Fields (Commission Case Header)                .
IF_EX_CACS_ELT_DOCUMENT        I SET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_REM       Set Customer Fields (Remuneration Line)                     .
IF_EX_CACS_MIGRATION_BZO       I ADD_CUST_FIELDS_SEG           Supplements Customer Fields for Segments                    .
IF_EX_CACS_MIGRATION_BZO       I ADD_CUST_FIELDS_SZO           Supplements Customer Fields for Assignments                 .
IF_EX_CACS_MIGRATION_BZO       I ADD_CUST_FIELDS_ZO            Supplements Customer Fields for Assignment Objects          .
IF_EX_CACS_MIGRATION_BZO       I ADD_WHERE_CLAUSE_CTRTBU_ID    Supplements Standard WHERE Clause with Own Attributes       .
IF_EX_CACS_MIGRATION_BZO       I ADD_WHERE_CLAUSE_SEGMENTS     Supplements Standard WHERE Clause with Own Attributes       .
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_CREBYRULE      I SETAWLCONTENT                 Fills Worklist for Object Assignment                        .
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_CTXT           I MAPCTXT                       Adopts Specified Context Information for Worklist           .
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_CTXT           I SELCTXTWPAR                   Selects Context Information By Selection Parameters         .
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_OBJSEL         I SELOBJSWID                    Gets Detailed Information on Objects with their ID          .
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_OBJSEL         I SELOBJSWPAR                   Selects Objects According to Predefined Selection Parameters.
IF_EX_CACS_OAWL_OBJSEL         I SELOBJSWPARID                 Searches Object List on Basis of Selection Parameters       .
IF_EX_CACS_TGT_CALC_RULE       I CALCULATE_ATTAINMENT_AMT      Calculate Level of Target Achievement (Amount)              .
IF_EX_CACS_TGT_CALC_RULE       I CALCULATE_ATTAINMENT_QTY      Calculate Level of Target Achievement (Quantity)            .
IF_EX_CACS_TGT_GENFLD_EVAL     I DETERMINE_FIELD_VALUE_AMT     Determine Value of Dynamic Field (Amount)                   .
IF_EX_CACS_TGT_GENFLD_EVAL     I DETERMINE_FIELD_VALUE_QTY     Determine Value of Dynamic Field (Quantity)                 .
IF_EX_CACS_TGT_TEMS_FILL       I DETERMINE_FIELD_VALUE         Get Field Value                                             .
IF_EX_CACS_WFMGCAS             I DETERMINEMESSAGEGROUP         Message Group Determination                                 .
IF_EX_CASL_CU51_DARK           I BOM_EXPLOSION_DARK            BOM Explosion in the Background                             .
IF_EX_CATSBW_CUST_ISOURCE      I DETERMINE_GRBIW               Determine "Rule Group: Reporting Time Types"                .
IF_EX_CATSBW_CUST_ISOURCE      I DETERMINE_SOURCE              Determination of Corresponding Delta Update DataSource      .
IF_EX_CATSBW_CUST_ISOURCE      I DETERMINE_STATUS              Determination of CATSDB Status to be Selected               .
IF_EX_CATSBW_CUST_ISOURCE      I POSTPROCESSING                Postprocessing of Selection Result                          .
IF_EX_CATSBW_CUST_ISOURCE      I SET_OFFSET                    Determination of Parameter OFFSET                           .
IF_EX_CATSXT_EVENT             I INITIALIZATION                Time Sheet Initialization                                   .
IF_EX_CATSXT_EVENT             I REGISTER_EMPLOYEE_EVENTS      Registration of Events in Class CL_EMPLOYEE_CATSXT          .
IF_EX_CATSXT_EVENT             I REGISTER_TIME_SHEET_EVENTS    Registration of Events in Class CL_TIME_SHEET_CATSXT        .
IF_EX_CATS_DERIVATIVES         I GET                           Provide Derivatives                                         .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I APPROVE_CATS_CLASSIC          Automatic Approval of a CAT2 Data Record?: Yes/No           .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I APPROVE_CATS_SERVICE_PROVIDER Automatic Approval of a CATSXT Data Record?: Yes/No         .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I APPROVE_TRIP                  Automatic Approval of a Trip?: Yes/No                       .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN           PAI for Selection Screen                                    .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN_OUTPUT    PBO for Selection Screen                                    .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I AUTH_CHECK_CATS_CLASSIC       Authorization Check for Working Time Data (CAT2)            .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I AUTH_CHECK_CATS_SERVICE_PROV  Authorization Check for Working Time Data (CATSXT)          .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I AUTH_CHECK_TRIP               Authorization Check for Trip Data                           .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I BEFORE_CATS_DATA_SELECTION    Before Selection of CATS Data from Database                 .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I BEFORE_DISPLAY                Working Time Data before Display on Screen                  .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I BEFORE_DISPLAY_APPR           Working Time & Trip Approval Before Display on Screen       .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I BEFORE_DISPLAY_DTL            Working Time Details Before Data Display                    .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I BEFORE_TRIP_DATA_SELECTION    Before Selection of Trip Data from the Database             .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I CATS_DATA_SELECTED            Process Selected CATS Data                                  .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I DOCUMENT_FLOW_SELECTED        Provide Selected Document Flow Data                         .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I INITIALIZATION                Report Initialization                                       .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I LOAD_OF_PROGRAM               Constructor for BADI                                        .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I START_OF_SELECTION            Start of Report Processing                                  .
IF_EX_CATS_REPORTING           I TRIP_DATA_SELECTED            Process Selected Trips                                      .
IF_EX_CATS_WORKLIST_ADDIN      I GET_WORKLIST                  Fill Worklist                                               .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I PROCESS_PUSH_BUTTON           Process Function Codes for Pushbuttons in Standard Toolbar  .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I SET_ALERT_ICON                Define Icons for Subnetwork Monitor                         .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I SET_ORDER_DATE                Copy Dates from Superior Networks to Subnetworks            .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I SET_SUBNETZE_DATA             Determine Additional Data for Superior Subnetworks          .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I SET_SUPACT_DATA               Transfer Additional Data to Superior Activity               .
IF_EX_CAUFVD_CHANGE            I UPDATE_PUSH_BUTTON            Create Pushbuttons for Standard Toolbar                     .
IF_EX_CAVE_SL_DOC_INBOUND      I DELIVERY_CHECK_UPDATE         Check Whether Delivery Has Been Changed in the Meantime     .
IF_EX_CCARD_UPDATE             I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Payment Card was Created or Changed                         .
IF_EX_CCHANGE_BAINN            I EXECUTE_ACTIONS               Carry out activities for country reassignments and leavings .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_EDGE                   Create Edge                                                 .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_NODE                   Create Node                                                 .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_OBJECT_ACTA            Create Mode                                                 .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_OBJECT_CMPV            Create Variante/Assembly Item                               .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_OBJECT_CONV            Create Solution Design                                      .
IF_EX_CCOLICUST_EXIT           I CREATE_OBJECT_RESN            Create Resource                                             .
IF_EX_CCSEQ                    I CONVERT_TYPE_NODE_REL         Converts Node Type into Relationship Type                   .
IF_EX_CCSEQ                    I CONVERT_TYPE_REL_NODE         Converts Relationship Type into Node Type                   .
IF_EX_CCSEQ                    I GET_DATA_FOR_NODES            Read and Format Data for CCSEQ_NODES_REBUILD                .
IF_EX_CCSEQ_CYCLE              I GET_AENNR_DESCRIPTION         Reads Change Number Description                             .
IF_EX_CCSEQ_CYCLE              I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Gets Cycle Data for Screen Enhancements                     .
IF_EX_CCVX_CONFIGURATION       I DO_NOT_MULTIPLE_SEND          Configurations Are to be Sent Multiple Times                .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I EXPORT_BOM                    Export of a Material BOM to cFolders                        .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I EXPORT_CFOLDERS               Export to a cFolders System                                 .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I EXPORT_DOCUMENTS              Export of a Document to cFolders                            .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I EXPORT_MATERIALS              Export of a Material to cFolders                            .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I THUMBNAILS_FILES              Choose Thumbnail to Be Displayed from List                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_ADD_FUNCTION       I THUMBNAILS_SIZE               Change Size of Thumbnails                                   .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_COPY_DLG      I SUPPRESS_DIALOG               Method to Suppress Dialog                                   .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_COPY_DOCTYPE  I COPY_DOC                      Copy Across the Document Type                               .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ACTIVATE_EXTENSION            Enhancements (Recovery, Display Option "Validity" And So On).
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I AFTER_CHECKIN                 Change After File Check-In                                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I APPEND_FILES_ON_CREATE        Attach File when Creating a Document Info Record            .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CHANGE_COLUMN_SET             Change Columns Set in Layout of CAD Desktop                 .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CHANGE_RFC_DESTINATIONS       Change RFC Destinations (SAPFTP, SAPHTTP)                   .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CHANGE_STRUCTURE              Change Structure Data                                       .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CHANGE_TAB                    On Change of View in CAD Desktop                            .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CHANGE_VERSION                Version Selection with CDESK_GET_VERSION                    .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Create Document with Dialog                                 .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CREATE_DOCUMENT_DARK          Create Document Without Dialog                              .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I CREATE_ECM                    Copy from Change Number when Creating                       .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I GET_ADDITIONAL_DRAWINGS       Where-Used List W/o Version to Find Additional Drawings     .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ICON_CHANGE                   Change Icons in SAP View and CAD View                       .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_CHECKIN                    Change Status, BOM and So On                                .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_DELETESTRUCTURE            Delete Structure (Header and Items)                         .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_FUNCTION                   Analysis of Function Code                                   .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_GETSTRUCTURE               Change When Reading the Document Structure                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_HASSTRUCTURE               Does the transferred document have a structure?             .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I ON_WHEREUSED                  Change for Where-Used List                                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I RENAME_AND_ADD_FILES          Rename Originals and Attach More Originals                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BADI_MAIN          I WORKDIR_FOLDER_STRUCTURE      Working Directory with Directory Structure                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I CHANGE_BOMDATA                Change Data for Material BOM                                .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I CHANGE_POSITION_DATA          Change Item Data, for Example Item Type, Item Number        .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I FIND_EXISTING_ITEMS           Item Determination During BOM Comparison                    .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I INSERT_ITEM                   Insert a New Item                                           .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I ON_CREATE                     Create/Change a BOM                                         .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I READ_CHILDREN                 Determines the Dependent Documents/Material Masters         .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I SELECT_MATERIAL               Determines Material Assigned to a Document                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I SHOW_MULTI_POSITION_DIALOG    Suppress Display of "Ambiguous" Dialog                      .
IF_EX_CDESK_BOM                I UPDATE_ITEM                   Change an Available Item                                    .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGE         I AFTER_CAD_CALLBACK            BAdI After CAD Callback                                     .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGE         I BEFORE_CAD_CALLBACK           BAdI Before/Instead CAD Callback                            .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGE         I GET_CAD_DATA_CALLBACK         BAdI Before and After C_DESK_GET_CAD_DATA Call              .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I AFTER_CAD_CALLBACK            BAdI Before CAD Callback                                    .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I BEFORE_CAD_CALLBACK           BAdI Before CAD Callback                                    .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I GET_ADDITIONAL_DRAWINGS       Where-Used List W/o Version to Find Additional Drawings     .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_CHECKIN                    To Change the Status, BOM and So On                         .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_DELETESTRUCTURE            Delete Structure (Header and Items)                         .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_FUNCTION                   Analysis of Function Code                                   .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_GETSTRUCTURE               Called When Reading the Document Structure                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_HASSTRUCTURE               Does the transferred document have a structure?             .
IF_EX_CDESK_CAD_CHANGEX        I ON_WHEREUSED                  Called for Where-Used List                                  .
IF_EX_CDESK_MATERIAL           I ON_CREATE                     On Creation of a Material Master (Background)               .
IF_EX_CDESK_MATERIAL           I ON_CREATE_DIALOG              On Creation of a Material Master (Foreground)               .
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I ADD_NEW_FUNCTIONS             Definitions from Toolbar Entries (Process Code, Layout, etc).
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I CHANGE_CONTEXT_MENU           Change of Standard Context Menu Entries                     .
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I CHANGE_ICON_SEARCH            Change Icons for Search in SAP/CAD View                     .
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I CREATE_CUSTOMER_FIELDS        Add Customer-Specific Fields to Field Catalog of CAD Desktop.
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS          Fill New Fields of Field Catalog                            .
IF_EX_CDESK_TBM_ADDIN          I PROCESS_NEW_FUNCTIONS         Process New Toolbar Entries                                 .
IF_EX_CDT_CHECK_MATERIAL       I CHECK_MATERIAL                Check a Material in a CDT                                   .
IF_EX_CDT_CHECK_MATERIAL       I DELETE_MATERIAL               Delete a Material in a CDT                                  .
IF_EX_CEI0_BATCH_INCONSIS      I SET_FLAG_INCONSISTENT         Inconsistent Configuration                                  .
IF_EX_CEI0_BATCH_NOF8          I SET_USER_BATCH_NO_F8          Set User-Specific NO_F8 Indicator for Batch Input           .
IF_EX_CEI0_CHECK_VALDOMAIN     I CHECK_DIRECTLY                Direct Value Check                                          .
IF_EX_CEI0_CHECK_VALUATION     I CHECK_VALUATION               Check Assigned Values                                       .
IF_EX_CEI0_COND_MAINTAIN       I CHECK_AUTHORITY_MACOND        Authorization Check: Assignment of Manual Conditions        .
IF_EX_CEI0_IDOC_DEFAULTS       I SET_FLAG_DEFAULTS             Read Default Values                                         .
IF_EX_CEI0_INVLD_POSSIBLE      I SET_FLAG_INVALID_POSSIBLE     Invalid Configuration - Time                                .
IF_EX_CEI0_NO_VALUE_DESCR      I SET_FLAG                      Set Indicator                                               .
IF_EX_CEI0_RMV_SCREENDEP       I SET_FLAG_RMV_SCREENDEP_VAL    Undo Values of SCREEN_DEP Characteristics                   .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_CUS_FIELDS      I BOM_CUS_DATA_GET_AT_PAI       Transfer of BOM Header Data from Enhancement (SAP)          .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_CUS_FIELDS      I BOM_CUS_DATA_GET_AT_PBO       Transfer of BOM Header Data in Enhancement                  .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_CUS_FIELDS      I BOM_CUS_DATA_PUT_AT_PAI       Transfer of BOM Header Data from Enhancement                .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_CUS_FIELDS      I BOM_CUS_DATA_PUT_AT_PBO       Transfer of BOM Header Data to Enhancement (SAP)            .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_CUS_FIELDS      I BOM_CUS_TAB_DESCRIPTION       Determine Description for Tab Title for Customer Fields     .
IF_EX_CEWB_BOM_UPDATE          I CHECK_BOM_AT_SAVE             Check Bill of Material on Saving                            .
IF_EX_CEWB_CHA_MENU_EXTERN     I CHA_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Inspection Characteristics               .
IF_EX_CEWB_CHA_MENU_INTERN     I CHA_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Inspection Characteristics               .
IF_EX_CEWB_COM_MENU_EXTERN     I COM_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Component Assignments                    .
IF_EX_CEWB_COM_MENU_INTERN     I COM_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Component Assignments                    .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I BOM_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for BOM Headers                              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I CHV_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Dependent Characteristic Specifications  .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I GET_VALIDITY_FOR_OBJECT       Checks Whether Extension Is Allowed for Object              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I MTK_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Material Extension for Material-Task List Assignments       .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I ODP_ITM_EXTENSION_EXTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for BOM Items               .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I ODP_OPR_EXTENSION_EXTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for Operations              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I ODP_PRT_EXTENSION_EXTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for PRTs                    .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I ODP_SEQ_EXTENSION_EXTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for Sequences               .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I PAC_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Maintenance Packages                     .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I PRT_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for PRT Assignments                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_EXTERN     I SEQ_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Sequences                                .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I BOM_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for BOM Headers                              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I CHV_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Dependent Characteristic Specifications  .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I GET_VALIDITY_FOR_OBJECT       Checks Whether Extension Is Allowed for Object              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I MTK_EXTENSION_INTERN          Material Extension for Material-Task List Assignments       .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I ODP_ITM_EXTENSION_INTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for BOM Items               .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I ODP_OPR_EXTENSION_INTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for Operations              .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I ODP_PRT_EXTENSION_INTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for PRTs                    .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I ODP_SEQ_EXTENSION_INTERN      Menu Extension for Dependencies for Sequences               .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I PAC_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Maintenance Packages                     .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I PRT_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for PRT Assignments                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_GEN_MENU_INTERN     I SEQ_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Sequences                                .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_CUS_FIELDS      I ITM_CUS_DATA_GET_AT_PAI       Transfer of BOM Item Data from Enhancement (SAP)            .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_CUS_FIELDS      I ITM_CUS_DATA_GET_AT_PBO       Transfer of BOM Item Data in Enhancement                    .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_CUS_FIELDS      I ITM_CUS_DATA_PUT_AT_PAI       Transfer of BOM Item Data from Enhancement                  .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_CUS_FIELDS      I ITM_CUS_DATA_PUT_AT_PBO       Transfer of BOM Item Data to Enhancement (SAP)              .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_CUS_FIELDS      I ITM_CUS_TAB_DESCRIPTION       Determine Description for Tab Title for Customer Fields     .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_MENU_EXTERN     I ITM_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for BOM Items                                .
IF_EX_CEWB_ITM_MENU_INTERN     I ITM_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for BOM Items                                .
IF_EX_CEWB_MST_MENU_EXTERN     I MST_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Trigger Points                           .
IF_EX_CEWB_MST_MENU_INTERN     I MST_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Trigger Points                           .
IF_EX_CEWB_MTK_MENU_INTERN     I MTK_EXTENSION_INTERN          Material Extension for Material-Task List Assignments       .
IF_EX_CEWB_OPR_MENU_EXTERN     I OPR_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Task Lists at Operation Level            .
IF_EX_CEWB_OPR_MENU_INTERN     I OPR_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Task Lists at Operation Level            .
IF_EX_CEWB_SEQ_MENU_INTERN     I SEQ_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Sequences                                .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_MENU_EXTERN     I TSK_EXTENSION_EXTERN          Menu Extension for Task Lists at Header Level               .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_MENU_INTERN     I TSK_EXTENSION_INTERN          Menu Extension for Task Lists at Header Level               .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHA_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PAICopy Characteristic Data from Enhancement                   .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHA_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Characteristic Data in Enhancement                     .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHA_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PAICopy Characteristic Data to Standard                        .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHA_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Characteristic Data to Enhancement                     .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHA_APP_DETAIL_SCREEN_DESCRIPTDetermine Description of Screen Enhancement for Char.       .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHV_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PAITransfer of Characteristic Values from Enhancement          .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHV_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PBOTransfer of Characteristic Values to Enhancement            .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHV_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PAITransfer of Characteristic Values to Standard               .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHV_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PBOTransfer of Characteristic Values to Enhancement            .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I CHV_APP_DETAIL_SCREEN_DESCRIPTDetermination of Desc. for Screen Enhancement of Spec. Char..
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I MTK_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PAITransfer of Assignment Data from Enhancement                .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I MTK_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PBOTransfer of Assignment Data to Enhancement                  .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I MTK_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PAITransfer of Assignment Data to Standard                     .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I MTK_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PBOTransfer of Assignment Data to Enhancement                  .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I MTK_APP_DETAIL_SCREEN_DESCRIPTDeterm. of Desc. for Screen Enh. of Material-Routing Assign..
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I OPR_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PAICopy Operation Data from Enhancement                        .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I OPR_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Operation Data in Enhancement                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I OPR_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PAICopy Operation Data to Standard                             .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I OPR_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Operation Data to Enhancement                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I OPR_APP_DETAIL_SCREEN_DESCRIPTDetermine Description of Screen Enhancement for Operation   .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I TSK_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PAICopy Task List Data from Enhancement                        .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I TSK_APP_DETAIL_GET_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Task List Data in Enhancement                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I TSK_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PAICopy Task List Data to Standard                             .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I TSK_APP_DETAIL_PUT_DATA_AT_PBOCopy Task List Data to Enhancement                          .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_SCREENS         I TSK_APP_DETAIL_SCREEN_DESCRIPTDetermine Description of Screen Enhancement for Task List   .
IF_EX_CEWB_TSK_UPDATE          I CHECK_TSK_AT_SAVE             Task List Check When Saving                                 .
IF_EX_CE_MON_EXIT1             I ALTERNATIVE_DISPLAY           Alternate Display Like SDP Project for Saudi Aramco         .
IF_EX_CE_MON_EXIT1             I EXTENS1                       Implementation of Menu Action +EXTENS1                      .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_DOCUMENT     I CHANGE_EXPORT_DEFAULTS        Change Default Values for cFolders Document Name, ...       .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_EXPORT_BOM_ATTRIBUTES  Change the Material BOM Attributes to Be Exported           .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_EXPORT_ITEM_ATTRIBUTES Change the Item Attributes to Be Exported                   .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_EXPORT_MAT_ATTRIBUTES  Change the Material Attributes to Be Exported               .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_IMPORT_BOM_ATTRIBUTES  Change the Material BOM Attributes to Be Imported           .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_IMPORT_ITEM_ATTRIBUTES Change the Item Attributes to Be Imported                   .
IF_EX_CFOLDERS_BI_MAIN01       I CHANGE_IMPORT_MAT_ATTRIBUTES  Change the Material Attributes to Be Imported               .
IF_EX_CFOP_DET_PREP            I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_SD          Change Interface Structure J_1BINCFOP                       .
IF_EX_CFOP_DET_PREP            I CHECK_PARAMETERS_SA           Check Input Parameter Changes in Sales                      .
IF_EX_CFOP_DET_PREP            I CHECK_PARAMETERS_SH           Check Input Parameter Changes in Shipping                   .
IF_EX_CFX_BI_EXPORT_BADI       I AFTER_EXPORT_COMPLETE         Obsolete. Use IF_CFX_BI_EXPORT instead.                     .
IF_EX_CFX_BI_EXPORT_BADI       I CHECK_EXPORT_CHANGE_PRE       Obsolete. Use IF_CFX_BI_EXPORT instead.                     .
IF_EX_CFX_BI_EXPORT_BADI       I CHECK_EXPORT_CREATE_PRE       Obsolete. Use IF_CFX_BI_EXPORT instead.                     .
IF_EX_CFX_BI_IPPE              I CHANGE_NODE_BEFORE_WRITE      Changes the Data of a Node Before Writing to iPPE           .
IF_EX_CFX_BI_IPPE              I CHANGE_VAR_BEFORE_WRITE       Changes the Data of a Variant Before Writing to iPPE        .
IF_EX_CGPL_FETCH_RELATIONS     I RELOAD_CHECK                  Check if Project/Task Has to Be Reloaded                    .
IF_EX_CHECK_COBL_ADDON         I CHECK                         Check Account Assignment                                    .
IF_EX_CHECK_DEVICES_B_NL       I CHECK_ACTION_ALLOWED          Check Whether Action is Permitted                           .
IF_EX_CHECK_INPUT_ACL          I CHECK_CNTR_UPD                Check input of counter updates                              .
IF_EX_CHECK_SAMPLE_DEVICES     I CHECK_NUMBER_OF_SAMPLE_DEVICESCheck Number of Sample Devices                              .
IF_EX_CIF_CP_CONDENSE          I MODIFY_CP_SELECTION           Change the results of the CIF ALE change pointer selection  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_BATCH_OUT              Change Transfer Data for Batch Master: IS-Specific          .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_CLASSIFIG_OUT          Change Transfer Data for Classification: IS-Specific        .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_CONTRACT_OUT           Change Transfer Data for Purchasing Contract: IS-Specific   .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_DELIVERY_BEFORE_IN     Change CIF Data for Delivery to IS-ERP Before Update        .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_IMOD_DESTINATION       Change Data of FB CIF_IMOD_DESTINATIONS_"object"            .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_MATERIAL_OUT           Change Transfer Data for Material Master: IS-Specific       .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_MAT_CLASSIF_ONLINE     Send Classification of Material Transfer Data: IS-Specific  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PIR_BEFORE_IN          Change CIF Data for PIR to IS-ERP Before Update             .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PIR_INITIAL_OUT        Change Transfer Data for PIR: IS-Specific (Initial Vers.)   .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PLPR_ORDER_AFTER_IN    Change CIF Data for Pl./Man. Order to IS-ERP After Update   .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PLPR_ORDER_BEFORE_IN   Change CIF Data for Pl./Man. Order to IS-ERP Before Update  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PLPR_ORDER_OUT         Change Transfer Data for Plan./Man. Order: IS-Specific      .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PLPR_ORD_DELTA3        Change Selection Data for Delta Report: IS-Specific         .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PUR_BEFORE_IN          Change CIF Data for Purchasing Document to IS-ERP Bef. Upd. .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PUR_ORD_OUT            Change Transfer Data for Purchase Order: IS-Specific        .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_PUR_REQ_OUT            Change Transfer Data for Purchase Requisition: IS-Specific  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_RESERVATION_BEFORE_IN  Change CIF Data for Reservation to IS-ERP Bef. Upd.         .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_RESERVATION_OUT        Change Transfer Data for Reservation: IS-Specific           .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SALES_ORDER_BEFORE_IN  Change CIF Data for Sales Order to IS-ERP Bef. Upd.         .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SALES_ORDER_OUT        Change Transfer Data for Sales Order: IS-Specific           .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SALES_ORDER_SELECT_OUT Change Selection for Sales Order: IS-Specific               .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SCHED_AGR_OUT          Change Transfer Data for Purch. Sched. Agrmnt: IS-Specific  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SHIPMENT_BEFORE_IN     Change CIF Data for Shipment to IS-ERP Bef. Upd.            .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_SHIPMENT_OUT           Change Transfer Data for Delivery/Shipment: IS-Specific     .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I CHANGE_STOCK_OUT              Change Transfer Data for Stock: IS-Specific                 .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I DELTA_ANONYMOUS_CHANGE_FOR_ERPChange Anonymous Data Container for CCR (Direction ERP)     .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I DELTA_FLTMATNR_CHANGE_FOR_APO Change Material/Plant Combinations for CCR (Direction APO)  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I DELTA_FLTMATNR_CHANGE_FOR_ERP Change Material/Plant Combinations for CCR (Direction ERP)  .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I DELTA_SEL_SALES_DATA          Selection of SD Data for AFS (Direction APO)                .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I EXTEND_PUR_REQ_KEY_COMPL      Extend the Key Completion Data for Purchase Requisitions    .
IF_EX_CIF_EXT_IS_INTERNAL      I PREPROCESS_PLPR_APOORD        Preprocess CIF Data for Plnd/Manufacturing Orders in IS-ERP .
IF_EX_CIF_FFFCLASS_001         I MODIFY_FFFCLASS_TRANSFER      Change FFF Classes Before Transferring to SCM               .
IF_EX_CIF_MRPDS                I BUFFER_TIME_CHANGE            Influence Buffer Time Calculation for Order Networks        .
IF_EX_CIF_RM_PPR_DISTRIB       I RRP_SEND                      Send Postprocessing Records to CIF                          .
IF_EX_CIF_SDLSE_001            I INITIAL_DATA_SCHED_AGR_ITEM   Initial Data Transfer for Sales Scheduling Agreement Items  .
IF_EX_CIF_SDLSE_002            I SCHED_AGR_ITEM_FILTER         Structure of Keys for CIF_IMSDLS                            .
IF_EX_CIN_EXCISE_CALCULATE     I TAXBASE_CHANGE_AFS            Changing the tax base for AFS                               .
IF_EX_CJ_DOCUMENT              I CHANGE                        Change Cash Journal Document                                .
IF_EX_CJ_DSAL_FUNC             I GET_MULTI                     Information for Multiple Selected Lines                     .
IF_EX_CJ_DSAL_FUNC             I GET_SINGLE                    Information for one Selected Line                           .
IF_EX_CJ_DSAL_FUNC             I SET_BUTTON                    Set User-Defined Pushbuttons in the DSAL                    .
IF_EX_CKMLAVR_SIM              I GET_PROTOCOL                  Returns the Log                                             .
IF_EX_CKMLAVR_SIM              I REFRESH_PROTOCOL              Deletes the Log                                             .
IF_EX_CKMLAVR_SIM              I SIMULATE_MATERIAL             Modifies ML Period Records for a Material                   .
IF_EX_CKMLDUVN_CHOOSE_RECV     I SET_PARAMETERS_RELEVANT       Indicates Whether Parameter is Relevant for Receiver Search .
IF_EX_CKMLDUVN_CHOOSE_RECV     I SUBSTITUTE_PARAMETERS         Substitute Parameters                                       .
IF_EX_CKML_AVR                 I GET_CKMLRUNSCALE              Reads Table CKMLRUNSCALE for Costing Run                    .
IF_EX_CKML_AVR                 I NEXTMON_POSTING_MODE          Posting Mode for Subsequent Period                          .
IF_EX_CKML_AVR                 I RUN_DELETE_DATA               Delete Application Data for Run                             .
IF_EX_CKML_COST_SPLIT          I GET_COST_SPLIT                Get Data for Apportionment with Joint Production            .
IF_EX_CKML_DISPLAY             I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Checks whether the AddOn CO_ML_DISPLAY is active            .
IF_EX_CKML_DISPLAY             I CHECK_CO_ML_WIP_EXISTS        Checks whether Package CO_ML_WIP exists                     .
IF_EX_CKML_DISPLAY             I GET_VORGANG_TEXT              Generate Text for Business Transaction                      .
IF_EX_CKML_DISPLAY             I NEW_CLOSINGDOC_DISPLAY        New Closing Document Display                                .
IF_EX_CKML_IF_REVAL_CONS       I WRAP_ACCOUNT_INFO             Encrypted FI/CO-Account Assignment for ML-Update            .
IF_EX_CKML_MGV_EXIT            I CUSTOMER_EXIT                 Change of Fields for Creating Alternatives                  .
IF_EX_CKML_MGV_EXIT            I GET_ACTIVITY                  Controls whether BADI should be used or not                 .
IF_EX_CKML_MLCCS               I LAST_RUN_GET_COPA             Last Posting Run                                            .
IF_EX_CKML_MLCCS               I LAST_RUN_GET_PCP              Last Posting Run                                            .
IF_EX_CKML_SETTLE              I CHECK_BADI_ACTIVE             Checks, Whether BADI is Used by Customer                    .
IF_EX_CKML_SETTLE              I CHECK_PRICE                   Checks, Whther Determined Price is Accepted By Customer     .
IF_EX_CKML_SET_VPRSV           I CHANGE_VPRSV                  Change Material Price Control                               .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I CURRENCY_TRANSLATION_RULES    Define Translation Rules for ML Currencies                  .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_CATEGORY               Modify process type and category                            .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_FI_CLOSING_TABLES      Mod ACCxx lines of transaction based settlement             .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_FI_TABLES              Modify ACCxx tables before ML update                        .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_ML_POSTING_TABLES      Modify all ML tables before posting                         .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_POSITION_SWITCHES      Modify switches for each position in ACCIT                  .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_STOCKLINE_SWITCHES     Modify switches of BSX lines                                .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I MODIFY_URZEILEN_SWITCHES      Modify switches for each item (Orig. line item)             .
IF_EX_CKML_UPDATE              I RESTORE_FI_TABLES             Restore ACCxx tables after ML update                        .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I BALI_CHECK_WIP_INPUT          Checks whether material has WIP as Input                    .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Checks whether 'WIP at Actual Costs' is activated           .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CHECK_PLANT_ACTIVE            Checks whether WIP quantity update is activated for plant   .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CHECK_RUN_ACTIVE              Checks whether WIP active plants are included in costing run.
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CLOSE_CREATE                  WIP Posting: Time CREATE with "Save Results"                .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CLOSE_MATERIAL                WIP Posting: Time "Edit Individual Object"                  .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CLOSE_POST                    WIP Posting: Time POST with "Save results"                  .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CLOSE_PREREAD                 WIP Posting: Time "Data Selection"                          .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CLOSE_RUN_ACTIVITIES          WIP Posting: Selection and Event Structure for Activities   .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_ACTUAL_QUAN_CALC       WIP Quantity Determination (Actual): Calculate Quantity     .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_DEQUEUE                WIP Quantity Determination: Unlock                          .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_DOCUMENT_SHOW          Display WIP Quantity Document in WIP Determination          .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_DOC_POST               WIP Quantity Determination: Post Document                   .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_ENQUEUE                WIP Quantity Determination: Lock                            .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_TARGET_DOC_CALL        WIP Qty Determ. (Target): Read GI-Quantity -" WIP Document  .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_TARGET_MD_STORE        WIP Quantity Determination (Targ.): Note Order/PKOSA        .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I CO_WIP_TARGET_QUAN_STORE      WIP Quantity Determination (Targ.): Note WIP Quantity       .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I ENRICH_BOM_WITH_WIP_OBJECTS   Enrich BOM with WIP Objects (Materials/Activities)          .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I FREE_WIP_LOGVIEW_BUFFER       Release of Logical WIP Buffer (Default Buffer)              .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_LA_BUFFER_READ            WIP Buffer: Read WIP Activity Type from Buffer              .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_MA_BUFFER_READ            WIP Buffer: Read WIP Material from Buffer                   .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_MLCCS_BUFFER_READ         WIp Buffer: Read CCS from WIP Object in Buffer              .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_MLCD_FROM_FELDG_FILL      Derive WIP Differences From Field Groups For MLCD           .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_OBJ_MLCD_CREATE           WIP Create MLCD Records from OBJWIP Documents               .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_PREREAD                   WIP Buffer: Read all WIP Objects in Buffer                  .
IF_EX_CKML_WIP                 I WIP_PRICE_DET_DOCUMENT_DISPLAYDisplay WIP Price Determination Document                    .
IF_EX_CK_KALAMATCON2_CI        I MODIFY_CI_MATCON2_USER        Maintenance of Additional CI Fields                         .
IF_EX_CLAIM_EXERCISER          I CALL_INTERFACE                Call of Claim Check System                                  .
IF_EX_CLAIM_EXERCISER          I FILL_INTERFACE_STRUCTURE      Preparation of Interface Structure                          .
IF_EX_CLEAR_DB_SAVE            I ON_CHANGE                     After Changing Data Cleansing Case                          .
IF_EX_CLEAR_DB_SAVE            I ON_CREATION                   After Creating Data Cleansing Case                          .
IF_EX_CLEAR_GUI_READ           I CHANGE_READ_DATA              Manipulation of Read DB Data                                .
IF_EX_CLEAR_GUI_SAVE           I GUI_POST_SAVE                 Application-Specific Enhancements After Saving (GUI)        .
IF_EX_CLEAR_GUI_SAVE           I GUI_PRE_SAVE                  Application-Specific Enhancements Before Saving (GUI)       .
IF_EX_CLIF_ACTIVATED           I HANDLE_CLASS_ACTIVATED        React to a Class Being Activated                            .
IF_EX_CLIF_ACTIVATED           I HANDLE_INTERFACE_ACTIVATED    React to an Interface Being Activated                       .
IF_EX_CLIF_CHECKED             I DO_ADDITIONAL_CHECK           Perform Additional Check for Class or Interface             .
IF_EX_CLIF_TOGGLE_DISPEDIT     I HANDLE_CLASS_TOGGLE           React to Switch Between Display/Change Mode for Class       .
IF_EX_CLIF_TOGGLE_DISPEDIT     I HANDLE_INTERFACE_TOGGLE       React to Switch Between Display/Change Mode for Interface   .
IF_EX_CLNT_DELFRM_COMM         I SEND_MESSAGE                  Sends message to MDS                                        .
IF_EX_CL_ATTRIBUTE_UPDATE      I ATTRIBUTE_UPDATE              Creating and Changing Attributes                            .
IF_EX_CL_ATTRIBUTE_USED        I ATTRIBUTE_USED                Where-Used List of Attributes                               .
IF_EX_CL_BR_XML_FILL           I FILL_XML_CUST                 Fill header structure & Item Table                          .
IF_EX_CL_NFE_PRINT             I CALL_RSNAST00                 Call Print Program                                          .
IF_EX_CL_NFE_PRINT             I CHECK_SUBSEQUENT_DOCUMENTS    Allow Checking of Subsequent Documents                      .
IF_EX_CL_NFE_PRINT             I FILL_HEADER                   Fill Additional Header Fields                               .
IF_EX_CL_NFE_PRINT             I FILL_ITEM                     Fill Additional Item Fields                                 .
IF_EX_CL_NFE_PRINT             I RESET_SUBRC                   Allow Printing of Non-Authorized NF-e                       .
IF_EX_CL_SD_NFTYPE             I MODIFY                        Modify NF Type per Line Item                                .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_DDS            I EVALUATE_SPONSORING           Evaluation the student sponsoring in fee calculation        .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_DDS            I READ_SPONSORING               Reading the student sponsoring within certain period        .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_ALL                       Modify student as well as prgram and module information     .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_DOC_CURRENCY              Modify document currency                                    .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_REG_SCINFO                Modify registered program of study information              .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_REG_SMINFO                Modify registered module informaiton                        .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_SCINFO                    Modify program of study information                         .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_SMINFO                    Modify module information                                   .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_PRICING        I SET_STINFO                    Modify student information                                  .
IF_EX_CMAC_BADI_TCMAC06D       I SET_TCMAC06D                  Default value for TCMAC06D                                  .
IF_EX_CMAC_DELTA_FEE           I CHECK_DELTA_FEE               Check delta fee and determine if it should be posted        .
IF_EX_CMAC_DELTA_GENERATE      I DELTA_GENERATION              Generate delta for BP items                                 .
IF_EX_CMAC_GRANTEVAL_CHECK     I GRANTEVAL_CHECK               Perform Checks Before Posting Grants                        .
IF_EX_CMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCK      I LOCK                          Lock                                                        .
IF_EX_CMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCK      I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_EX_CMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCKS     I LOCK                          Lock                                                        .
IF_EX_CMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCKS     I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_EX_CME_CHAR_EMULATION       I CHECK                         Check Characteristic Data                                   .
IF_EX_CME_EMULATION            I CHECK                         Check Characteristic Data                                   .
IF_EX_CME_VALUES               I CHECK_DELETION_DESCRIPTIONS   Check Run When Deleting Value Texts                         .
IF_EX_CME_VALUES               I CHECK_DELETION_VALUES         Check Run When Deleting Values                              .
IF_EX_CMIG_ACT_NAME            I CMIG_BUILD_NODE_NAME          Generate PVS Node Name from Routing                         .
IF_EX_CMIG_BOM_ALTPOS          I SELECT_ITEM                   Selection: Alternative Item                                 .
IF_EX_CMIG_BOM_CI_STKO         I CONVERT                       Copy Customer Fields                                        .
IF_EX_CMIG_BOM_CI_STPO         I CONVERT                       Copy Customer Fields                                        .
IF_EX_CMIG_BOM_NAME_HD_NOD     I CREATE_NAME                   Name Assignment: Access Nodes for iPPE Migration BOM        .
IF_EX_CMIG_BOM_NAME_ST_VAR     I CREATE_NAME                   Name Assignment: Item for iPPE Migration of BOM             .
IF_EX_CMPD_CUS_ASSIGNMENT      I AFTER_VALIDATION              Change Assignment - Called After Validation                 .
IF_EX_CMPD_CUS_ASSIGNMENT      I BEFORE_VALIDATION             Change Assignment - Called Before Validation                .
IF_EX_CMPD_CUS_EXECUTE         I CAMPAIGN_DETERMINATION        Execute Campaign Determination                              .
IF_EX_CMS_ACR_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Aircraft Data                                         .
IF_EX_CMS_ANL_CR               I CALC_COLL_RIGHT               Determine the Nominal value and Collateral Right for a CAG  .
IF_EX_CMS_ANL_DIST_CV          I DISTRIBUTE_COLL_VALUE         Distribution of Collateral Value                            .
IF_EX_CMS_ANL_DIST_LR          I DISTRIBUTE_LENDING_RANGE      Distribution of Lending Range                               .
IF_EX_CMS_API_LIQ_IF_OBJ       I GET_MLT                       Get Object Details                                          .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Asset and its related data                            .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_C_CHECK          I CHECK_BP                      Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_C_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check Asset Details                                         .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_C_CHECK          I CHECK_DOC                     Check Document Details                                      .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_DIALOG           I GET_DATA_FROM_SCR             Get Data from Screen                                        .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_DIALOG           I GET_OBJTYP_BY_ASTTYP          Get Object type by Asset type                               .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_DIALOG           I GET_SCR_DATA                  Get Screen Data                                             .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_DIALOG           I MAINTAIN                      Maintain Object                                             .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_DIALOG           I PUT_DATA_TO_SCR               Put data to Screen                                          .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_G_CHECK          I CHECK_BP                      Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check Asset Details                                         .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DOC                     Check Document Details                                      .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_NON_DIALOG       I CHECK_EXISTS                  Check if the object exists                                  .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_NON_DIALOG       I GET_LIST                      Get list                                                    .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_NON_DIALOG       I GET_MLT                       Get multiple object details                                 .
IF_EX_CMS_AST_NON_DIALOG       I GET_SNG                       Gets single object details                                  .
IF_EX_CMS_BDL_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Bundles Data                                          .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_AST              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Assets                          .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_CAG              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Collateral Agreements           .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_LIQ              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Liquidation Measures            .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_LIQ_CFL          Modifiy, Map and Distribute Liquidation Cash Flows          .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_MOV              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Movable Objects                 .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_RBL              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Receivable                      .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_REO              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Real Estate Objects             .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_RIG              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Rights                          .
IF_EX_CMS_BII_DEX_MAP_DIST     I MOD_MAP_DIST_SEC              Modifiy, Map and Distribute Securities Account              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I F4_HELP                       Business Partner F4 Help                                    .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I GET                           Get Business Partner Details                                .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I GET_ADDRESS                   Get Business Partner Address Details                        .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I INPUT                         Output Format to Input Format                               .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I MAINTAIN                      Maintain Business Partner (Create/Change/Display)           .
IF_EX_CMS_BUPA                 I OUTPUT                        Input Format to Output Format                               .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB100_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB100_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_GENLNK     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_GENLNK     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_LNK_CR     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB101_LNK_CR     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB103_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB103_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB103_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB103_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB104_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB104_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB104_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB104_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB105_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB105_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB105_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB105_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB106_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB106_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB106_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB106_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB107_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB107_CREATE     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB107_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB107_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB108_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Processing of Import Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB108_GET        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Processing of Export Parameters in MAPI Format              .
IF_EX_CMS_BUSISB112_CREATE     I HANDLE_EXTENSIONS_BEFORE      Handle customer extensions before the Mapi call             .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_ADDL_COST        I ADDITIONAL_COST_CALCULATE     Calculation of  additional costs                            .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Collateral Agreement and related data                 .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_C_CHECK          I CHECK_BP                      Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_C_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check CAG Details                                           .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_C_CHECK          I CHECK_DOC                     Check Document Details                                      .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_C_CHECK          I CHECK_RULES                   Check CAG Rules                                             .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_G_CHECK          I CHECK_BP                      Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check CAG Details                                           .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DOC                     Check Document Details                                      .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_G_CHECK          I CHECK_RULES                   Check CAG Rules                                             .
IF_EX_CMS_CAG_RBL_G_CHECK      I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check Agreement-Receivable Link Details                     .
IF_EX_CMS_CHG_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check Charge Details                                        .
IF_EX_CMS_CLM_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Claims Data                                           .
IF_EX_CMS_DEV_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Device Data                                           .
IF_EX_CMS_DOC                  I CHECK                         Checks on the data of a document                            .
IF_EX_CMS_DOC                  I EXISTS_ID                     Check if document id exists                                 .
IF_EX_CMS_DOC                  I F4_HELP                       Search a document                                           .
IF_EX_CMS_DOC                  I GET                           Get Document details                                        .
IF_EX_CMS_DOC                  I MAINTAIN                      Maintain a Document (Create, Change and Display)            .
IF_EX_CMS_INS_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Insurance Data                                        .
IF_EX_CMS_INV_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Inventory Data                                        .
IF_EX_CMS_IR                   I GET_MLT                       Receivable Get Detail                                       .
IF_EX_CMS_IR                   I GET_PRD_CLASS                 Get Product Class by semantic key                           .
IF_EX_CMS_IR_DLG_F4            I F4                            Search for Receivable                                       .
IF_EX_CMS_IR_DLG_MAINT         I MAINTAIN                      Maintain Receivable                                         .
IF_EX_CMS_IR_GET_LIST          I GET_LIST                      Get List of Receivable Keys                                 .
IF_EX_CMS_OBJ_SYS              I CHECK                         Check Object (Validation of the Object ID)                  .
IF_EX_CMS_OBJ_SYS              I MAINTAIN                      Maintain Object (Create/Change/Display)                     .
IF_EX_CMS_OTH_VAL_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check Other Valuables Data                                  .
IF_EX_CMS_PAT_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Patents Data                                          .
IF_EX_CMS_RBL_G_CHECK          I CHECK_BP                      Check Business Partner Details                              .
IF_EX_CMS_RBL_G_CHECK          I CHECK_DETAILS                 Check Receivable Details                                    .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_G_CHECK           I CHECK                         Check Real estate Data                                      .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR                I ASSIGN                        Assign Land Register entries to a RE Object                 .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR                I CHECK                         Check existance of Land Registry entry                      .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR                I MAINTAIN                      Branch from the RE Object to the Land Register              .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I CHECK_LR_DATA                 Called for checking the LR data                             .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I END_DIALOG                    Called while ending the dialog                              .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I GET_LR_REF                    Gets the Land Register references back                      .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I HANDLE_FCODE                  Passes the FCODE(s) to be handled                           .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I PASS_LR_REF                   Passes the Land Register references                         .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I REFRESH_LR_DATA               Called on refresh of RE data                                .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_DIALOG         I SAVE_LR_DATA                  Called on save on RE data                                   .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_LR_ID             I GET                           Determines the Land Register identifier                     .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_OBJ_SAVE_ONLN     I SAVE_DATA                     Method to save data in external applications                .
IF_EX_CMS_RE_VAL_ONLN          I VALUATE                       Performs valuation of real estate based on Master data      .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_BANK_ID          I CHECK_EXIST                   Check existence of a bank id                                .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_BANK_ID          I F4_HELP                       F4 help to search for a bank id                             .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_BANK_ID          I GET_DETAIL                    Get name and address details of bank                        .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_GET_ADD_DATA     I CHECK_EXIST                   Check existence of isin in external system                  .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_GET_ADD_DATA     I F4HELP                        F4 help for ISIN                                            .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_GET_ADD_DATA     I GET                           Get ISIN details from external class master data system     .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_GET_ADD_DATA     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Put external class master data in securities subscreen      .
IF_EX_CMS_SEC_VAL_ONLN         I VALUATE                       Performs securities positions valuation for a securities acc.
IF_EX_CMS_SHP_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Ships Data                                            .
IF_EX_CMS_VEH_CHECK            I CHECK                         Check Vehicles Data                                         .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_ACTION_CANCEL              Access when resetting a confirmed activity                  .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_ACTION_COMPLETE            Access after successful completion of an activity           .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_ACTION_EXECUTE             Access to execute an application-specific activity          .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_ACTION_PREPARE             Access to confirm an activity with a status change          .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_ACTION_SELECT              Access for selection of activities that can be carried out  .
IF_EX_CMX_XSR_SRV_XSV          I ON_NODE_CREATE                Access After Creation of a Node                             .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_BATCH_JOBS       I CONFIGBASELINES_CREATED       Baselines created                                           .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_BATCH_JOBS       I CONFIGBASELINES_EXPLODED      Baselines exploded                                          .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_BATCH_JOBS       I CONFIGBASELINES_FIXED         Baselines fixed                                             .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_BATCH_JOBS       I JOB_PARAMETERS                Infos on job                                                .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_CONTROLLER       I GET_INSTANCE                  Instance of Alternative Controller Class                    .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_CUST_CHECK       I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Customer-Specific Authorization Check                       .
IF_EX_CM_BADI_SET_SCREEN       I SET_SCREEN_FOR_CREATE_BL      Default Field Values for Creation of Baseline (in FG CMPOP2).
IF_EX_CM_BADI_VERSION          I GET_ACTIVE_VERSION            Active Software Version                                     .
IF_EX_CM_QUOTATION_INSERT      I QUOTATION_INSERT              Quotation Value Handling for Updating                       .
IF_EX_CNAR_WBS_ELEMENT         I ALLOW_WBS_ELEMENT_DELETION    Allow Deletion of WBS Elements                              .
IF_EX_CND_MAP_CONV_FIELD       I CONVERSION                    Conversion of Field Contents                                .
IF_EX_CNEVWB_CONFIRMATION      I UPDATE_CONFIRMATION           Update Confirmation Values in Progress Analysis Workbench   .
IF_EX_CNEV_01_METHODS          I CHANGE_INDIVIDUAL             Change Progress Method for Object                           .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I ADD_COMPONENT_CHECK_011       Check a Newly Assigned Component                            .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I CHANGE_COMPONENT_CHECK_005    User Exit for Checking Changes to Components in Order       .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I CHANGE_COMPONENT_CHECK_012    Check a changed component                                   .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I CHECK_SOS_ACTIVE_015          Source Determination in Network                             .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I PLANT_LGORT_SET_007           Customer Enh.: Plant, Storage Loc. Determination for  Comp. .
IF_EX_CNIF_MAT_UPDATE          I REMOVE_COMPONENT_CHECK_013    Check Whether Component can be Deleted                      .
IF_EX_CNS_CP_DELETE            I SELECT_CP4_DELETION           Delete Change Pointer from List of Deletion Candidates      .
IF_EX_CNTR_DFLT_ACL            I SET_CNTR_DFLT                 Sets default counter update values                          .
IF_EX_CNTR_DFLT_ACL            I SET_MEAS_DOCS                 Sets values of measurement documents                        .
IF_EX_CNTR_UPD_ACL             I SET_CNTR_UPD                  Set the counter updates                                     .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_ADD_DATA        I ALLOCATE_DOCS_TO_ITEM         Determination of Documents for Item                         .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_ADD_DATA        I ALLOCATE_LTXT_TO_ITEM         Determining Long Texts for an Item                          .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I DELETE_ITEM_MAPPING           Delete Item Mapping                                         .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I MAP_HEADER                    Map Header                                                  .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I MAP_ITEM                      Map Item                                                    .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I READ_ITEM_KEYS                Read Item Key for a BOM                                     .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I WRITE_HEADER_MAPPING          Update Header Mapping                                       .
IF_EX_CNV_CTRL_MAPPING         I WRITE_ITEM_MAPPING            Update Item Mapping                                         .
IF_EX_COCF_ORDCNF              I DETERMINE_SHIFT               Determine Current and Possible Shifts                       .
IF_EX_COCF_ORDCNF              I GET_CU_QUANT_ID               Determine Customizing ID for Quantity/Error Combinations    .
IF_EX_COCF_WORKLIST            I ADDITIONAL_PROBL_CHECKS       Execute Additional Checks                                   .
IF_EX_COCF_WORKLIST            I FILL_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS        Fill Additional Fields in Worklist                          .
IF_EX_COCF_WORKLIST            I GET_DETAIL_COMPONENT          Provide Additional Web Dynpro Component                     .
IF_EX_COCM2                    I ACTIONS_DECIDE                Decision on Action in Batch Processing                      .
IF_EX_COCM2                    I ACTIONS_PROVIDE               Transfer of Table Changes (AFFW, IMSEG and EMSEG)           .
IF_EX_COELEM_AND_GLACCOUNT     I CHECK_COELEM_GLACCT_ALLOWED   Enable Secondary Cost Element + G/L Account                 .
IF_EX_COINT_CUS_TRFERP         I COINT_TP_COSTEL_GET           Controlling Integration: Determine Reposting Cost Element   .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I BAL_READ_CALLBACK             Application Log: Callback for Display                       .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I BUILD_ALV_TABLE               Structure of ALV Table                                      .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I DELETE_LINES_FROM_ALV         Deletes Lines from the ALV Table                            .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I GIVE_CONSTANTS                Delivers the Business Scenario Constants                    .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I GIVE_OBJNR_FOR_EXTID          CO Object Number EXT_OBJECT_ID, if Available                .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I MODIFY_BAL_DISP_PROF          Change Display Profile for Application Log                  .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I MODIFY_COERR_MESSAGE_INPUT    Change Import Parameter COERR_MESSAGE*                      .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I MODIFY_FILTER_MSG_EXTNR_READ  Postprocess Selection Criteria                              .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I SEARCHHELP_APPL_EXIT          Search Help Exit Application                                .
IF_EX_COINT_ERR                I SHOW_OBJECTS_IN_ALV           Display Worklist in ALV Grid                                .
IF_EX_COL_MODULE_EXTENSION     I AFTER_QUERY_EXECUTE           After Executing a Query                                     .
IF_EX_COL_MODULE_EXTENSION     I BEFORE_QUERY_EXECUTE          Before Executing a Query                                    .
IF_EX_COMM_SET_ATTR_CHECK      I CHECK_ATTRIBUTES              Checks the List of Attributes                               .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_ALERT                Completes Alert Processing                                  .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_FAX                  Completes Fax Processing                                    .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_MAIL                 Completes Mail Processing                                   .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_METHOD               Completes BADI Processing                                   .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_PRINT                Completes Print Processing                                  .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_SEND                 Completes Transmission Processing                           .
IF_EX_COMPLETE_PROC_PPF        I COMPLETE_WORKFLOW             Completes Workflow Processing                               .
IF_EX_COM_BSP_WORKFLOW         I READ_WORKITEMS_FOR_OBJECT     Read Object Workflows                                       .
IF_EX_COM_BW_TEXT_EXT          I TEXT_EXT_DETAILS_SET          Set Properties of a Text DataSource                         .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I COM_CFG_CHECK_CONF_AND_SRV    Calls Module COM_CFG_CHECK_CONF_AND_SRV                     .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I COM_PME_SCE_FIND_KBS          Calls Module COM_PME_SCE_FIND_KBS                           .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I COM_PME_SCE_GET_CLASS_CSTICS  Calls Module COM_PME_SCE_GET_CLASS_CSTICS                   .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I COM_SCE_CONFIG_RESULT         Calls Module COM_SCE_CONFIG_RESULT                          .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I COM_SCE_HAS_DATA              Calls Module COM_SCE_HAS_DATA                               .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_CREATE_CONFIG             Calls Module IPC_CREATE_CONFIG                              .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_GET_CONFIG_ITEM_INFO      Calls Module IPC_GET_CONFIG_ITEM_INFO                       .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_GET_KNOWLEDGEBASE         Calls Module IPC_GET_KNOWLEDGEBASE                          .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_INIT_CONFIG               Calls Module IPC_INIT_CONFIG                                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_SET_PROPERTY              Calls Module IPC_SET_PROPERTY                               .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_IPC_MODULES     I IPC_SHOW_CONFIG               Calls Module IPC_SHOW_CONFIG                                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I COM_PME_DB_GET_CLASS_INFO     Reads All Data of a PME Class                               .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I COM_PME_KB_DEQUEUE            Calls PME Function Module COM_PME_KB_DEQUEUE                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I COM_PME_KB_DEQUEUE_BUNDLE     Calls PME Function Module COM_PME_KB_DEQUEUE_BUNDLE         .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I COM_PME_KB_ENQUEUE            Calls PME Function Module COM_PME_KB_ENQUEUE                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I COM_SCE_GET_CLASS_INFO        Gets Class Info from IPC/SCE Runtime (Performance)          .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I CRM_SCE_DB_KB_DELETE          Calls Module CRM_SCE_DB_KB_DELETE                           .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I KB_GET_CHANGED_KBS            Get Changed kbs of a PME Session                            .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_ADD_CSTIC                 Calls PME RFC PME_ADD_CSTIC                                 .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_CHECK_VALUES              Calls PME RFC PME_CHECK_VALUES                              .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_CLOSE_SESSION             Closes a PME Session                                        .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_CREATE_KB                 Calls PME RFC PME_CREATE_KB                                 .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_CREATE_OO_CLASS           Calls PME RFC PME_CREATE_OO_CLASS                           .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_DELETE_CLASS              Calls PME RFC PME_DELETE_CLASS                              .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_DELETE_KB                 Calls PME RFC PME_DELETE_KB                                 .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_GET_CLASS_CSTICS          Calls PME RFC PME_GET_CLASS_CSTICS                          .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_GET_CLASS_INFO            Calls PME RFC PME_GET_CLASS_INFO                            .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_GET_DOMAIN                Calls PME RFC PME_GET_DOMAIN                                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_GET_VALUES                Calls PME RFC PME_GET_VALUES                                .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_GET_XREF                  Calls PME RFC PME_GET_XREF                                  .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_HAS_XREF                  Calls PME RFC PME_HAS_XREF                                  .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_OPEN_OO_CLASS             Calls PME RFC PME_OPEN_OO_CLASS                             .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_OPEN_SESSION              Opens a PME Session                                         .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_REMOVE_CLASS_PARENT       Calls PME RFC PME_REMOVE_CLASS_PARENT                       .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_RESTRICT_DOMAIN           Calls PME RFC PME_RESTRICT_DOMAIN                           .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_SAVE_SESSION              Saves a PME Session                                         .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_SET_CLASS_DESCRIPTIONS    Calls PME RFC PME_SET_CLASS_DESCRIPTIONS                    .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_SET_CLASS_PARENT          Calls PME RFC PME_SET_CLASS_PARENT                          .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_SET_CSTIC_DESCRIPTIONS    Calls PME RFC PME_SET_CSTIC_DESCRIPTIONS                    .
IF_EX_COM_CALL_PME_MODULES     I PME_SET_VALUES                Calls PME RFC PME_SET_VALUES                                .
IF_EX_COM_CATEGORY_FRGTYPE     I GET_CLIENT_ORG_TYPES          Returns All Permitted Organizational Types in Clients       .
IF_EX_COM_CAT_DEL_CHECK        I CATEGORY_DELETION_CHECK       Check Whether Category Can Be Deleted                       .
IF_EX_COM_CAT_ID_HANDLING      I CONVERT_KEY_CCTID_TO_INT      Conversion: CCT Identifier --" Category GUID                .
IF_EX_COM_CAT_ID_HANDLING      I CONVERT_KEY_INT_TO_CCTID      Conversion: Category GUID --" CCT Identifier                .
IF_EX_COM_CAT_ID_HANDLING      I GET_CATEGORY_ID               Copy Category GUID and Category ID of Sending System        .
IF_EX_COM_CFG_IDCONV           I GET_EXTERNAL_ID               convert internal id to external representation              .
IF_EX_COM_CFG_IDCONV           I GET_INTERNAL_ID               convert external id to internal representation              .
IF_EX_COM_CFG_PVAR             I GET_ALL_VARIANTS              get product variants of kmat                                .
IF_EX_COM_CFG_PVAR             I GET_VARIANT                   get configuration of product variant                        .
IF_EX_COM_DOC_COMMPR01         I CHECK_DOC_CHANGED             Method for Checking the Attribute SET_DOC_CHANGED           .
IF_EX_COM_DOC_COMMPR01         I SET_DOC_CHANGED               Method for Setting the Attribute SET_DOC_CHANGED            .
IF_EX_COM_HIERARCHY_DELETE     I DELETE_HIERARCHY              Hierarchy Being Deleted                                     .
IF_EX_COM_HIER_ID_HANDLING     I CONVERT_KEY_CCTID_TO_INT      Conversion: CCT Identifier --" Hierarchy GUID               .
IF_EX_COM_HIER_ID_HANDLING     I CONVERT_KEY_INT_TO_CCTID      Conversion: Hierarchy GUID --" CCT Identifier               .
IF_EX_COM_HIER_ID_HANDLING     I GET_HIERARCHY_ID              Copy Hierarchy GUID and Hierarchy ID of Sending System      .
IF_EX_COM_IL_CHECK             I CHECK                         Check for Validity of a Relationship                        .
IF_EX_COM_IL_CHECK_OBJTYPE     I CHECK_ILTYPE_ALLOWED          Check of IL Type Can Be Maintained for Source Object Type   .
IF_EX_COM_IL_GEN               I DEFINE_RELTYPE_OBJECTS        Object Definition/Table Entries for a Relationship Type     .
IF_EX_COM_IL_GEN_PCUI          I DEFINE_PCUI_LAYOUT            Define PC-UI Layout for a Relationship Type                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_CHECK          I CHECK_ASSIGNED_SETTYPES       Checks for Assigned Set Types and Views                     .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I CHANGE_CHECK                  Check on data changes                                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I FREE                          Free                                                        .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I INIT                          Iinitialise                                                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I MAINTAIN                      Maintain                                                    .
IF_EX_COM_PRCAT_UI             I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_ID_HANDLING      I GET_PRODUCT_ID                Copy Product GUID and Product ID of Sending System          .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_ID_HANDLING      I KEY_CONVERSION_ALTID_TO_CCTID Conversion: Alternative IDs --" XI Product-ID               .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_ID_HANDLING      I KEY_CONVERSION_CCTID_TO_INT   Conversion: XI Product-ID --" Product GUID                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_KEYTYPE          I CONVERT_KEY_CCTID_TO_INT      Conversion Differentiation Key: CCT ID --" Internal         .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_KEYTYPE          I CONVERT_KEY_INT_TO_CCTID      Conversion Differentiation Key: Internal --" CCT ID         .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_MASS_DECOUPL     I GET_NAVIGATION_INFO           Gets URL and JavaScript Code for Navigation                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_MASS_DECOUPL     I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Delivers Object Type for MASSTAB Entry                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_MASS_DEC_ECM     I CHECK_ECM_IS_SUITABLE         Checking Change Number                                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_MASS_DEC_ECM     I GET_LAST_ECM_FOR_PRODUCT      Get the Change Number Last Used to Change the Object        .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_MASS_DEC_ECM     I UNLOCK_ECMS                   Unlock All Locked Change Numbers                            .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_POST_FILTER      I FILTER_PRODUCT_DATA           Filter Product Data Before Updating                         .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_TEXTKEY          I CONVERT_TEXTKEY_INT_TO_PROXY  Conversion Long Text Key: Internal --" Proxy Structure      .
IF_EX_COM_PRD_TEXTKEY          I CONVERT_TEXTKEY_PROXY_TO_INT  Conversion Long Text Key: Proxy Structure --" Internal      .
IF_EX_COM_PRID_CONVERSION      I MATNR18_MATNR40_CONVERT       Conversion 18 Digit "-" 40 Digit Material Number            .
IF_EX_COM_PRID_CONVERSION      I PR_UPLOAD_MATNR_CONVERT       Conversion Product GUID "-" Material Number (MARA-MATNR)    .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I INSERT_ENTRIES                New Entries                                                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I READ_MULTI                    Mass Read                                                   .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I READ_MULTI_HISTORY            Mass Read of History Records                                .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I READ_SINGLE                   Read Single                                                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I READ_SINGLE_HISTORY           Read Single History Record                                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ADD_DATA     I UPDATE_ENTRIES                Changed Entries                                             .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I CST_CHECK_MULTIGROUP          Customer Set Types: Control Tabstrips                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I CST_CHECK_TABSTRIP            Customer Set Types: Control Tabstrips                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I CST_F4_HELP_GENERIC           F4 Help for Customer-Defined Set Types (Generated)          .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I CST_MAC_CHANGE                Changing MAC for the Blueprint Generation Set Types         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I DET_TAX_STATE                 Tax Status                                                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_DISTR_CHAN            F4 Help for Distribution Channel                            .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_DURATION_UOM          F4 Help for Unit of Measure for Work Duration               .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_FIELDS                General F4 Help for Fields                                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_MAINTAINED_UOMS       F4 Help for Maintained Units of Meaurement                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_RESIDVL               F4 Help for Financing-Dependent Attributes                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_SALES_ORG             F4 Help for Sales Organization                              .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_SALES_STATUS          F4 Help for Sales Status                                    .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I FILL_F4_TAXES                 F4 Help for Taxes                                           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I MAP_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Find Search Criteria                                        .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP          I REMOVE_TAX                    Event Execution                                             .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I CHECK_MULTI_OBJECTS_ACE       Determine Activities for Multiple Objects in ACE            .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I CHECK_SINGLE_OBJECT_ACE       Determine Activities of an Object in Access Control Engine  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I GET_AUTHORIZATION_MODE        Determine Authorization Mode                                .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I PREPARE_SEARCHSCENARIO        Integration of Search Scenario                              .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I SET_NEW_OBJECTS_ACE           Register New Objects in Access Control Engine               .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_ACE      I SET_UPDATE_OBJECTS_ACE        Register Changed Objects in Access Control Engine           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT      I CHECK_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP         Read Active Tabs                                            .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I CHECK_ACTIVE_MULTIGROUP       Check Active Multi-Groups                                   .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I CHECK_ACTIVE_TOOLBAR          Read Active Pushbuttons                                     .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I CREATE_PRODUCT                Create Product                                              .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I FILL_DDLB                     Fill Dropdown List Box                                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I FILL_EVENTGROUP               Fill Event Group                                            .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I GET_MESSAGES                  Read Error Messages                                         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I GET_MY_FAVORITES              Determine Favorites                                         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I MAP_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Find Search Criteria                                        .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I MODIFY_PRODUCT                Modify Product                                              .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I PROCESS_EVENT                 Event Execution                                             .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I QUERY_PRODUCT                 Find Product                                                .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I READ_FOCUS_OBJECT             Read Data (with Focus Object)                               .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_EXT_FLT  I READ_PRODUCT                  Read Product                                                .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_F4       I FILL_F4_FIELDS                Befüllen von F4-Hilfe für SAP-eigene Settypenfelder         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_BSP_NAVI     I CHANGE_LINK_PARAMETERS        Overwrite Link Parameter                                    .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_COPY         I CHANGE_DETAILS                Change of Detail Data                                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_COPY         I CHANGE_DST_BASE_CAT           Change of Target Product Base Category                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_COPY         I CHANGE_SETTYPES               Change Set Types to Be Copied                               .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_COPY         I COPY                          Copy Data When Creating Product Buffer                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_COPY         I COPY_LATE                     Copy Data After Creating Product Buffer (Documents)         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_DELETE       I DELETE_EXTRA_DATA             Delete Additional Data (Not Created in Set Types)           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I CHECK_ECM                     Check Change Number                                         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I CONSISTENCY_CHECK             Check Consistency of Transferred Data                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I DEACTIVATE_CHECK              Check if Flag NO_ECM Can Be Reset                           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I DETERMINE_LAST_ECM            Determine Last Change Request                               .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I REGISTER_PRODUCT_IN_ECM       Register Product in Change Number                           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_ECM          I REPLICATE_LINKS_ON_NEW_ECM    Replicate Links for New Change Number                       .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_LOGSYS       I GET_MESSAGE_TYPE              Message Type (In case set is not maintained in orignal sys.).
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_PRWB         I DEACTIVATE_COMMPR01           Leave Product Workbench                                     .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_RECATEG      I DELETE_CHECK                  Checks if Data Is to Be Deleted                             .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_RECATEG      I DELETE_OTHER_DATA             Deletion of Additional Data During Recategorization         .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_RECATEG      I DELETE_OTHER_DATA_API         Deletion of Additional Data from API Structure              .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_TAX_BSP      I DET_TAX_STATE                 Tax Status                                                  .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_TAX_BSP      I FILL_F4_TAXES                 F4 Help for Taxes                                           .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_TAX_BSP      I REMOVE_TAX                    Delete Tax Data Record                                      .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_UI_MENU      I FCODE_ENV                     Menu Extension Under "Environment"                          .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_UI_MENU      I FCODE_ENV2                    Menu Extension Under "Environment"                          .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_UI_MENU      I FCODE_GOTO                    Menu Extension Under "Goto"                                 .
IF_EX_COM_PRODUCT_UI_MENU      I FCODE_GOTO_DISABLED           Menu Extension Under "Goto"                                 .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_ALL         I FILL_LOCAL_BUFFER             Fill Maintenance Buffer for Active / Inactive Save          .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_ALL         I REFRESH_ALL                   Reset All Buffers                                           .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_ALL         I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_API         I CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT_STRUCTURE  Convert from External to Internal Format                    .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_API         I MAINTAIN_PRODUCT_MULTIPLE     Maintain Data for Several Products                          .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_UI          I CHANGE_CHECK                  Checks for Changed Data                                     .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_UI          I PROCESS_AFTER_SAVE            After Saving a Product                                      .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_UI          I REFRESH_ALL                   Release Buffer                                              .
IF_EX_COM_PROD_MNT_UPD         I CHANGE_AFTER_UPDATE           Products Were Created or Changed                            .
IF_EX_COM_RELATION_BSP         I CHECK_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP         Checks Current Tabs of the Relationships                    .
IF_EX_COM_RELATION_BSP         I CHECK_ACTIVE_TOOLBAR          Checks Current Toolbar Group of the Relationships           .
IF_EX_COM_RELATION_BSP         I READ_WHERE_USED               Reads Relationship Type Data                                .
IF_EX_COM_SETTYPE_WZ_SUB       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Read from Subscreen                                    .
IF_EX_COM_SETTYPE_WZ_SUB       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transfer to Subscreen                                  .
IF_EX_COM_SET_MV_ATTR          I CHECK_PRODUCT_TYPES           Check product types                                         .
IF_EX_CONF_POST_EXT            I CHECK                         Check for External Posting                                  .
IF_EX_CONTAINER_PPF            I MODIFY_CONTAINER              Modify Condition and Parameter Container                    .
IF_EX_CONTEXT_DELETE_PPF       I DELETE_ALLOWED                Deletion Allowed?                                           .
IF_EX_CONTEXT_EXTEND_PPF       I EXTEND_CONTEXT                Extend Context                                              .
IF_EX_CONVERTER_MAIN01         I CHECKIN_AFTER_CHECKIN         Delete Files After Check-In                                 .
IF_EX_CONVERTER_MAIN01         I CHECKIN_BEFORE_CHECKIN        Change Descript., Storage Cat., etc of Files Before Check-In.
IF_EX_CONVERTER_MAIN01         I CHECKIN_CHANGE_WS_APPLICATION Change WA of Files Before Check-In                          .
IF_EX_CONVERT_TO_DUVA          I CONVERT                       Convert the report to custom format.                        .
IF_EX_CONVERT_TO_DUVA          I DOWNLOAD                      Convert into the downloadable format and download.          .
IF_EX_CONVERT_TO_DUVA          I GENERATE_HEADER               Generate the header.                                        .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I CHECK_DEST                    Check RFC destination                                       .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I CHECK_FILE_EXIST              Check Existence of Checked Out Files                        .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I CONNECTION_CLOSE              Close Open RFC Connections                                  .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I CONVERT                       Start Conversion                                            .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I CREATE_DIRECTORY              Create Directory in (Virtual) File System                   .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I DELETE_DIRECTORY              Delete Directory in (Virtual) File System                   .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I DOC_CHECKIN                   Check-In Result Originals                                   .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I DOC_CHECKOUT                  Check-Out Result Originals                                  .
IF_EX_CONV_INTERNAL            I GET_DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR       Return Directory Separator for (Virtual) File System        .
IF_EX_CONV_OWN_WF_SLAVE        I SET_TASK                      Set Slave Workflow                                          .
IF_EX_CONV_OWN_WF_SLAVE        I UPDATE_CONV_FILE              Update or Delete Entry in CONV_FILE                         .
IF_EX_CONV_SWITCH_TO_WF        I SET_FLAG_WF                   Activate Workflow                                           .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_ACCSYS_REPL      I REPLACE_ACCSYSTEM_GET         Replace Accounting System by Another Entity                 .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_ACCSYS_REPL      I REPLACE_ACCSYSTEM_SET         Replace Accounting System by Another Entity                 .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I ACTUAL_DISTR                  Actual Cost Distribution with Joint Production              .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I ACTUAL_REPORTING_DISTR        Cost Distribution with Joint Production for Reporting       .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I FIXED_PRICE_COPROD_VALUATION  Cost Distribution for Fixed-Price Joint Products            .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I GET_IMPLEMENTED               Check Whether BADi Method Is Implemented                    .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I MAT_COSTING_DISTR             Cost Distribution with Joint Production for Material Costing.
IF_EX_CON_FIN_COPROD_DISTR     I ORD_COSTING_DISTR             Cost Distribution with Joint Production for Precosting      .
IF_EX_CON_FIN_MANUF_ORDER      I VALCLASS_DETERMINE            Derivation of Valuation Class for WIP Account               .
IF_EX_COOCC_MILL_VP            I MILL_CHECK_CONFIG_MTS         Check configurable Make-to-Stock                            .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKB_IDOC        I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_FILL          Create COELEM IDoc - Insert Customer Fields                 .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKB_IDOC        I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_UPDATE        Post COELEM IDoc - Customer Fields                          .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKB_IDOC        I IDOC_TYPE_GET                 Create COELEM IDoc - Request Customer IDoc Type             .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKS_IDOC        I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_FILL          Create COSMAS-IDoc - Insert Customer Fields                 .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKS_IDOC        I CUSTOMER_FIELDS_UPDATE        Post COSMAS Idoc - Customer Fields                          .
IF_EX_COOM_CI_CSKS_IDOC        I IDOC_TYPE_GET                 Create COSMAS IDoc - Check Customer Enhancement IDOC Type   .
IF_EX_COOM_RESP_USER           I CONVERT_RESP_USER_BP          Determines User ID of Person Responsible for Business Proc. .
IF_EX_COOM_RESP_USER           I CONVERT_RESP_USER_CC          Determines User ID of Person Responsible for Cost Center    .
IF_EX_COOM_RESP_USER           I CONVERT_RESP_USER_IO          Determines User ID of Person Responsible for Internal Order .
IF_EX_COOM_RESP_USER           I CONVERT_RESP_USER_PC          Determines User ID of Person Responsible for Profit Center  .
IF_EX_COPCMESSAGECONTROL       I MODIFY_CONTROLLABLE_MESSAGE   Modify User-Definable Message                               .
IF_EX_COPC_CKMCSO              I CK_MCSO_SELECTION             Selection of Items To Be Costed                             .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I DELETE                        Delete Data for Run                                         .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I DISPLAY_LOG                   Display Log                                                 .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I MAP_STEP_TO_REPORT            Determine Report Name for Step                              .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I MODIFY_GRID                   Modify Output List                                          .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I PRINT_LOG                     Print Log                                                   .
IF_EX_COSTINGRUN_CK            I PROCESS_PREPARE               Selection Variant Administration                            .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I CREATE_COMPOSITE_FROM_DB      Called to Instantiate Item Category 0                       .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I CREATE_FROM_DB                To Instantiate Unknown Item Categories                      .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I ON_BEGIN_OF_CALCULATE         Called Before Price Calculation                             .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I ON_CREATE_FROM_DB             Called During Instantiation of Database                     .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I ON_DELETE                     Costing Item Is Deleted                                     .
IF_EX_COSTING_COMPONENT        I ON_END_OF_CALCULATE           Called After Valuation                                      .
IF_EX_COST_APPORTION_CK        I COST_SPLIT_RULE_ACTIVATE      Activate Maintenance for Distribution Rules                 .
IF_EX_COST_APPORTION_CK        I COST_SPLIT_RULE_CHECK         Check Selected Distribution Rule                            .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_AFTER_ITEMIZATION_CALCULATEItemization has been revaluated                             .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_COMMIT_ALL                 Cost estimates are posted                                   .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_CONVERT_TO_KEKO            CONTROL DATA and HEADER Transferred to KEKO                 .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_DELETE                     Cost estimate is deleted                                    .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_MASSDATA_PREREAD           Array Fetch                                                 .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_READ_FROM_DB               Cost estimate is read from the database                     .
IF_EX_COST_ESTIMATE            I ON_SAVE_TEMPORARILY           Cost estimate is saved temporarily                          .
IF_EX_CO_ALE_INBOUND_EVENT     I CODCMT                        Inbound CODCMT IDoc Type                                    .
IF_EX_CO_DOCUMENT_INFO         I SHOW_DOCUMENTS                Delivers CO Documents in Tables                             .
IF_EX_CO_LIMIT_COAREA          I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check Before Saving V_TKA01_GD                              .
IF_EX_CO_ML_WIP                I QUANTITY_CALC_ACTUAL          Quantity Determination in WIP at Actual Costs Scenario      .
IF_EX_CO_ML_WIP                I QUANTITY_CALC_TARGET          Quantity Determination in WIP at Target Costs Scenario      .
IF_EX_CO_OM_PLAN_ITEM_CHECK    I CHECK_VALUES                  Check of Values                                             .
IF_EX_CO_PROD_COSTING_CK       I FIXPRICE_COPROD_VALUATION     Valuation for Fixed-Price Co-Product                        .
IF_EX_CO_PROD_COSTING_CK       I MATERIAL_COSTING              Mat.Costing: Determine Factor (Equiv. No.) for Co-Products  .
IF_EX_CO_PROD_COSTING_CK       I MATERIAL_TARGET_COSTING       Target Cost Calc. for a Material Cost Estimate with Co-Prod..
IF_EX_CO_PROD_COSTING_CK       I ORDER_COSTING                 Prel. Order CostEst: Value Determination for the Co-Products.
IF_EX_CO_PROD_COSTING_CK       I ORDER_TARGET_COSTING          Target Cost Determ. for an Order Cost Estimate with Co-Prod..
IF_EX_CO_SRULE_CDOC            I GET_FLG_CDOC                  Get Change Document Indicator                               .
IF_EX_CO_SRULE_CHECK           I DISTRIBUTION_RULE_CHECK       Verify Distribution Rule                                    .
IF_EX_CO_VERSION_CUSTOM        I CHECK_VERSION_CREATE_OR_CHANGEAdditional Version Checks When Creating/Changing            .
IF_EX_CO_VERSION_CUSTOM        I CHECK_VERSION_DELETE          Additional Version Checks When Deleting                     .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I BUILD_FIELDCATALOG            FORM BUILD_FIELDCATALOG                                     .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I CHANGE                        Change Object                                               .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I CHANGE_REMOTE_ENTRY           Exit for Remote Browsing (Key Change)                       .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I CONVERT_PRODUCT_STRUCTURE     FORM CONVERT_PRODUCT_STRUCTURE                              .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I CREATE_PRODUCT_TREE_CONTROL   FORM CREATE_PRODUCT_TREE_CONTROL                            .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I DATE_FROM_ECN                 Set Date from Change Number                                 .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I DISPLAY                       Display Object                                              .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I EXPAND_DOCUMENT_OBJECT_LINK   Object Link Expanded                                        .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I EXPAND_TREE_STRUCTURE_BRANCH  FORM EXPAND_TREE_STRUCTURE_BRANCH                           .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I EXPAND_TREE_STRUCTURE_BRA_INITFORM EXPAND_TREE_STRUCTURE_BRANCH; Initialization           .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_ADDITIONAL_FILTER         Filter: Define Additional Filter Categories                 .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_DOCUMENT_OBJECT_LINKS     Get Additional Object Links to Document                     .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_FILTER_TOP_OBJECTS        Insert New Objects to Filter                                .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_OBJECT_FACTORY            Get Factory Object for Object Type                          .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_OBJECT_FILTER_RESTRICTION Filter: Insert Restrictions on Object Level                 .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_OBJECT_RELATIONS          Filter: Insert Object-Specific Entries                      .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_RELATION                  Add (Additional) Dependency                                 .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I GET_RELATIONS                 Add (Additional) Dependencies                               .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I HANDLE_CTMENU_FUNC            Event Handler: Edit Popup Menu Entry                        .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I HANDLE_NODE_CTMENU_AT_END     Event Handler: Add Entries to End of Popup Menu             .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I HANDLE_NODE_CTMENU_AT_START   Event Handler: Add Entries to Start of Popup Menu           .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I HANDLE_NODE_DBLCLICK          Event Handler: Double Click Event                           .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I INHERIT_ICON_CANCEL_SPECIAL   Filter: Deactivate Object Relationships                     .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I INVOKE_GLOBAL_BROWSER         FORM INVOKE_GLOBAL_BROWSER                                  .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I INVOKE_LOCAL_BROWSER          FORM INVOKE_LOCAL_BROWSER                                   .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I ON_DRAG                       Drag&Drop-Enabling                                          .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I ON_DROP                       Drag&Drop-Enabling                                          .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I REFRESH_BROWSER               FORM REFRESH_BROWSER                                        .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I REFRESH_BROWSER_INIT          FORM REFRESH_BROWSER; Initialization                        .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I REFRESH_BROWSER_TOPLEVELOBJ   FORM REFRESH_BROWSER for Top Level Objects                  .
IF_EX_CPDMBROWSEREXTENSION     I SET_FILTER_FORM               Filter: Set Form Routine for Individual Filters             .
IF_EX_CPE_FILL_TEXT_TABLES     I FILL_TEXT_TABLES              Fill CPE Customizing Text Tables                            .
IF_EX_CPFX_SCREEN_SET          I INPUT_DISABLED                Sets Screen Entry to Not Ready for Input                    .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHANGED                       Check if Changes Were Made                                  .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHANGED_FOR_GROUP             Check if Changes Were Made at Current X Steps               .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGDOC_FILTER                 Filter Change Documents                                     .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGDOC_OBJID_GET              Determine Object IDs for Change Documents of X Steps        .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGDOC_OBJTXT_GET             Determine Text for Object ID of Change Documents            .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGDOC_PROG_GET               Determine Formatting Routine for Change Documents           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_DET                     Determine Change Numbers                                    .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_DET_ROUTINGS            Specify Task Lists for Change Number                        .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_SHIFT                   Change Number Shift                                         .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_SHIFT_CHECK             Check if Change Number May Be Shifted                       .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_USAGE                   Check if Change Number Was Used                             .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CHGNO_WRITE                   Determine Change Numbers                                    .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CONCATENATE                   Concatenate Execution Steps                                 .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I CONSISTENCY_CHECK             Consistency Check                                           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I COPY_COMPLETE                 Copy from Exection Step Trees: Table-Supp. Context Switch   .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I EDIT                          Edit Execution Steps (Without Editor)                       .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I EDITOR                        Call Up Editor for Execution Step Maintenance               .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I EDIT_PRES                     Determine Processing Type (PI or execution steps)           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I EXIST                         Determine Existence of PI Set/Execution Step for Header     .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I EXIST_DATA                    Determine PI Set/X Step Existence for Header Incl. Validity .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I FINALIZE                      PI Set/Execution Step Completion                            .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I HDR_CONTEXT_CHANGE            Change Operation Context in PI Set/Execution Step           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I HISTORY_GET                   Read History                                                .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I HISTORY_PRINT                 Output History                                              .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I HISTORY_PRINT_OBJ             History Output: Object Text                                 .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize PI Sets/Execution Steps                          .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I MIGRATION                     XStep Migration                                             .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I OPR_CONTEXT_CHANGE            Change Operation Context in PI Set/Execution Step           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I PFL_CONTEXT_CHANGE            Change Operation Context in PI Set/Execution Step           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I PLAN_EXTERNAL_NUMBERING_SET   Change Operation Context in PI Set/Execution Step           .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I PROFILE_CONSISTENCY_CHECK     Determine Consistency of Profile for Task List Group        .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I PROFILE_EDIT_PRES             Determine Processing Type from Profile (PI, PS/ES)          .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I PS_GUID_GET                   Determine GUID of PI Set/Execution Step Tree                .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I REFRESH                       Remove PI Sets/X Steps Loaded from Memory (Without Saving!) .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I REG_SAVE                      Update Registration                                         .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I REORG_ARCHIVE                 Archive in Reorganization                                   .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I REORG_DELETE                  Delete in Reorganization                                    .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I REPORT_PRINT                  Display PI Sets/Execution Steps in Print Report             .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I SIMULATE                      Simulation                                                  .
IF_EX_CPS_EXECUTION_D          I SYNTAX_CHECK                  Syntax Check                                                .
IF_EX_CP_DIG_SIGNATURE         I EXECUTE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE     Creation of a Digital Signature                             .
IF_EX_CP_DIG_SIGNATURE         I PREPARE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE     Preparation of the Digital Signature                        .
IF_EX_CRHRORG                  I CHECK_DEASSIGN_HRORG          Action Before Removing HR Assignment                        .
IF_EX_CRHRORG                  I CHECK_DELETE_WORKCENTER       Action Before Deleting a Work Center                        .
IF_EX_CRHRORG                  I CHECK_SET_DELFLAG             Action When Setting the Deletion Indicator                  .
IF_EX_CRM_ACC_SEARCH           I CHECK_OBJECTS                 Check and Filter Objects                                    .
IF_EX_CRM_ACC_SEARCH           I DISABLE_IMPLICIT_SEARCH       Disable Implicit Search when Entering New                   .
IF_EX_CRM_ACC_SEARCH           I QUERY                         Search Exit for Customer Include                            .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I CHANGE_ACRMETHOD              Change Accrual Method                                       .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I CHANGE_ACRTYPE                Change Accrual Type                                         .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I CHANGE_DATA_BEA               Change Billed Data                                          .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I CHANGE_DATA_CRM               Change CRM Data Created in Accrual Engine                   .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I SAVE_ON_COMMIT                Save Data on Commit Work                                    .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_INBOUND_BADI     I SET_COMP                      Change Component                                            .
IF_EX_CRM_ACE_POSTING_BADI     I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA              Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I AFTER_ROLLBACK_DELETE         Deletion Failed                                             .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I CHECK_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP         Read Active Tab Pages                                       .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I CHECK_ACTIVE_TOOLBAR          Read Active Pushbuttons                                     .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I CHECK_BEFORE_DELETE           Check if Deletion is Allowed                                .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I DELETE                        Delete Data                                                 .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I FILL_DROPDOWN_LISTBOX         Read Dropdown Listbox Values                                .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I GET_MY_FAVORITES              Read Favorites                                              .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I PROCESS_EVENT                 Execute Event                                               .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I READ                          Read Data                                                   .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_ACCMOD           I READ_FOCUS_OBJECT             Read Data (with Focus Object)                               .
IF_EX_CRM_BSP_BAB              I AFTER_SAVE                    Applications Can React to Saving in BAB                     .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_BPSEARCH     I CHANGE_REL_APPLICATIONS       modify relevant applications                                .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_BPSEARCH     I CLEAR                         clear                                                       .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_BPSEARCH     I GET_OKCODES                   get supported OK-codes                                      .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_BPSEARCH     I HANDLE_OKCODE                 handle OK-code                                              .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_BPSEARCH     I INITIALIZE                    initialization                                              .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_REM_INFO     I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Change fieldcatalog                                         .
IF_EX_CRM_CIC_ASP_REM_INFO     I GET_INFO                      Get information                                             .
IF_EX_CRM_CONS_UPDATE          I GM_ITEM_MERGE                 Material Item for Consignment Stock Posting                 .
IF_EX_CRM_IC_F4_SYSTEM         I GET_F4_SYSTEM_PROPERTIES      Fetermine System properties for a specific F4 context       .
IF_EX_CRM_IC_MCM_PHN_BADI      I EXTEND                        Extend Phone Number                                         .
IF_EX_CRM_QM_NOTIF             I MAP_BAPIMTCS_TO_QM_NOTIF      Quality Notification - Mapping of Data                      .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_DT               I CHECK                         Run a diagnosis check                                       .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_DT               I GET_CHECK_PARAMETERS          Get parameters needed for checks                            .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_IS               I GET_SECURITY_CRITERIA         Get security criteria from kb specific security rule        .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_IS               I GET_SECURITY_PATTERNS         Get security patterns given a set of criteria               .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_KB               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITIONS     Get attribute definitions, e.g., grouping of attributes     .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_KB               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_SEARCH_RETURN   Get attribute name returned with search hitlist             .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_KB               I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Get attribute set with values for display/search            .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_KB               I RETRIEVE_BATCH                Retrieve next batch of knowledge entities                   .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_KB               I RETRIEVE_DETAIL               Retrieve details of a set of knowledge entities             .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_SE               I COMPOSE_REQUEST               Compose http requests for actions                           .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_SE               I COMPOSE_REQUEST_SEARCH        Compose http requests for search action                     .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_SE               I PARSE_RESPONSE                Parse http response for actions                             .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_SE               I PARSE_RESPONSE_CHECK          Parse http response for checking index                      .
IF_EX_CRM_SAF_SE               I PARSE_RESPONSE_SEARCH         Parse http response for search hitlists                     .
IF_EX_CRM_SDEXCHG_BADI         I FILTER_DATA                   Filter Data for CRM Download                                .
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_ACCT_TOOL        I DETERMINE_TOOL_COSTS          Determine Tools and Account Assignment                      .
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_AUTOLOG_BADI     I CRM_SRV_LOG_AUTO_HANDLING     Determine Logistics Scenario                                .
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_MAP_PO_BADI      I CHECK_UPDATE_PO               Decision About Change of Purchase Order W/Out Export Trade  .
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_MAP_PO_BADI      I CHECK_UPDATE_PO1              Decision About Change to Purchase Order                     .
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_MAP_PO_BADI      I MAP_PO                        Mapping of CRM Data to R/3 Purchase Orders W/Out ExportTrade.
IF_EX_CRM_SRV_MAP_PO_BADI      I MAP_PO1                       Mapping of CRM Data to R/3 Purchase Orders                  .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADIS_1             I SCHEDULED_REPLI_DEF_BASELINE  Name of the Baseline for Creating CRWB_SCHEDULED_REPLICATION.
IF_EX_CRWB_BADIS_1             I WF_GENERATE_BASELINES         Generates UPS distribution units/packages in CVDI workflow  .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS       I CHANGE_UPSTYPE_ECN            Determine UPS Object Type for ECM When Adding               .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS       I GEN_UPS_DATA                  Reprocess Baseline Dates for UPS                            .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS       I MODIFY_UPS_DATA               Process UPS After Filtering                                 .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS       I POSTPROCESS_UPS_DATA          Process UPS After Closing the Packet                        .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS_I     I CHANGE_UPSTYPE_ECN            Determine UPS Object Type for ECM When Adding               .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS_I     I GEN_UPS_DATA                  Reprocess Baseline Dates for UPS                            .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS_I     I MODIFY_UPS_DATA               Process UPS After Filtering                                 .
IF_EX_CRWB_BADI_MODI_UPS_I     I POSTPROCESS_UPS_DATA          Process UPS After Closing the Packet                        .
IF_EX_CR_WORKCENTER_SELECT     I CLASS_SEL                     Execute Class Selection                                     .
IF_EX_CSIM_FILTER              I CSIM_COMPARE_NODES            User-Exit for the Comparison of Nodes                       .
IF_EX_CSIM_FILTER              I CSIM_FILTER                   Filtering of Nodes                                          .
IF_EX_CSIM_FILTER              I CSIM_NEW_ATTRIBUTES_POSITION  Reads New Data Gields for Items of the Config. Simulation   .
IF_EX_CSIM_FILTER              I CSIM_SORT                     Sorting of the Nodes                                        .
IF_EX_CSO_WSSS                 I CSO_DLVRIES_OPEN_NOT_NEW_DLV  No new deliveries while there are open deliveries           .
IF_EX_CSO_WSSS                 I CSO_DLVRIES_OPEN_NOT_PROCESS  Switch off processing of open deliveries                    .
IF_EX_CSO_WSSS                 I CSO_DLVRY_SUPPRESS_BILLING    Billing, Switch Off Goods Issue                             .
IF_EX_CSO_WSSS                 I CSO_SCDLIN_DLV_READ_END       Manipulation of Delivery Schedule Lines During Import       .
IF_EX_CTS_CURRENT_PROJECT      I GET_CURRENT_PROJECT           Determine current project                                   .
IF_EX_CTS_EXPORT_FEEDBACK      I FEEDBACK_AFTER_EXPORT         Feedback after export of a transport request                .
IF_EX_CTS_IMPORT_FEEDBACK      I FEEDBACK_AFTER_IMPORT         Feedback after import of transport requests                 .
IF_EX_CTS_INT_REQUEST_CHCK     I CHECK_BEFORE_RELEASE          Internal: Checks before releasing a request                 .
IF_EX_CTS_REQUEST_CHECK        I CHECK_BEFORE_ADD_OBJECTS      Checks Before Inserting Table Key                           .
IF_EX_CTS_REQUEST_CHECK        I CHECK_BEFORE_CHANGING_OWNER   Checks before change of owner                               .
IF_EX_CTS_REQUEST_CHECK        I CHECK_BEFORE_CREATION         Checks before creating a request                            .
IF_EX_CTS_REQUEST_CHECK        I CHECK_BEFORE_RELEASE          Checks before releasing a request                           .
IF_EX_CTS_TASKDOC_TEMPLATE     I GET_TEMPLATE_OBJECT           Determine the name of the documentation template            .
IF_EX_CTS_TMS_NAVIGATE         I ROUTE_CONSISTENCY_CHECK       Check Route Consistency for Change Manager                  .
IF_EX_CTS_WBO_NAVIGATE         I TRANSPORT_REQUES_CREATE       Generate Transport Request                                  .
IF_EX_CTUT1_UPDATE_OBJECT      I CHANGE_TABLE_OF_OBJECTS       Change to Table with Uses                                   .
IF_EX_CTWUL_LOCDEP_OWNER       I SET_OWNER_LOCDEP              Set Owner (Characteristic or Class) of a Local Dependency   .
IF_EX_CTWUL_OTHER_USAGES       I GET_USAGE                     Where-Used List for Characteristics/Characteristic Values   .
IF_EX_CTWUL_OTHER_USAGES       I SHOW_OBJECT                   Display Object Using                                        .
IF_EX_CUCP_UPDATE_OBJECT       I CHANGE_TABLE_OF_OBJECTS       Change to Entries in Config. Object Table                   .
IF_EX_CUCQ_MULTI_FOR_RESB      I SET_MULTILEVEL_FLAG           Set Indicator                                               .
IF_EX_CUD0_READ_KNOWLEDGE      I SET_READ_KNOWLEDGE_SWITCH     See BAdI Documentation (Choose Back or F3)                  .
IF_EX_CUD2_SUPPRESS_LINES      I GET_SUPPRESS_FILTER           Determine Filter for Hiding Lines                           .
IF_EX_CUDUI_MISSED_CHAR        I CHECK_CHAR_MISSED_ALLOWED     Check Whether Non-Existent Characteristics Are Allowed      .
IF_EX_CUKO_PLANT_CHANGE        I CUKO_SET_CHANGE_PLANT_FLAG    Flag EV_ALLOW_PLANT_CHANGE Is Set.                          .
IF_EX_CUKO_STL_PERSONAL        I STL_TABLES_HANDLING           Method works with tables and structures for BOM order       .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I CHANGE_CIF_STRUCTURES         Change CIF Transfer Tables                                  .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I CHANGE_EWB_STRUCTURES         Change Master Data                                          .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I CHANGE_OPERATION              Change Activities/Modes from a Transaction                  .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I CHANGE_REQCAP                 Process REQCAP Table                                        .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I NO_RESOURCE_WORKCENTER_CLASS  Consider Resources/Work Center Classification               .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I OPERATION_TRANSFERED          Transfer of Activities without Duration                     .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I PDS_IMO_SELECTION             Correct Selection for Integration Model                     .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I TRANSFER_ALLOWED              Change Transfer Allowed                                     .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I TRANSFER_FINISHED             Handling After the Transfer                                 .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I TRANSFER_STD_ROUTING          Transfer of Changes to Reference Operation Set              .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN          I USE_OPERATION_CLASSIFICATION  Read Classification for Block Planning                      .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN_SAP      I CHANGE_CIF_STRUCTURES         Change CIF Transfer Tables                                  .
IF_EX_CUSLNTRTO_ADDIN_SAP      I GET_FILTER                    Determine Active Implementation                             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADDRSCR_CHG     I GET_FILTERVALUE_ADDR_SUBSCREENDetermination of Filter Value for BAS Subscreen             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADDRSCR_CHG     I GET_KNA1_ADDITIONAL_DATA      Transfer Additional KNA1 Values from BAS Screen             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADDRSCR_CHG     I SET_KNA1_ADDITIONAL_DATA      Transfer Additional KNA1 Values to BAS Screen               .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I BUILD_TEXT_FOR_CHANGE_DETAIL  Builds Text Line for Details of Field Change                .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I CHECK_ACCOUNT_NUMBER          Check the Customer Number if External Number Assignment     .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I CHECK_ADD_ON_ACTIVE           Check Whether Add-On Connection Should Be Activated         .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I CHECK_ALL_DATA                Final Checks                                                .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Check whether Data Changed Outside of Standard              .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I GET_CHANGEDOCS_FOR_OWN_TABLES Read Change Documents for Own Tables                        .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I INITIALIZE_ADD_ON_DATA        Initialization of Add-On Work Structures                    .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I MODIFY_ACCOUNT_NUMBER         Revise the Customer Number if Internal Number Assignment    .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I PRESET_VALUES_CCODE           Preassign KNB1 Dependent of the General Data                .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I PRESET_VALUES_SAREA           Preassign KNVV Dependent of the General Data                .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I READ_ADD_ON_DATA              Read Add-On Data                                            .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I SAVE_DATA                     Save Data Outside Standard                                  .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA        I SET_USER_INPUTS               Transfer of User-Inputs to ADD-ON                           .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I CHECK_DATA_ROW                Checks a Data Row                                           .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I FILL_ALE_SEGMENTS_OWN_DATA    Fill ALE Segments in ALE Outbound Processing                .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I FILL_BI_TABLE_WITH_OWN_SEGMENTFill Batch Input Table from Own Segment (ALE Inbound Proc.) .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I FILL_FT_TABLE_USING_DATA_ROWS Fills FT Table (Add-On Part) with Values From Data Rows     .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I MODIFY_BI_STRUCT_FROM_STD_SEG Change BI Structure from Standard Segment                   .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I PASS_NON_STANDARD_SEGMENT     Pass On Customer-Defined Segments (ALE Inbound Processing)  .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_BI     I PROCESS_ALE_OWN_CHANGE_POINTEREvaluate Own Change Pointer                                 .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I GET_DATA                      Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I GET_FIELDNAME_FOR_CHANGEDOC   Transfer Field Name for Change Document Display             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I GET_TAXI_SCREEN               Determine Screen for Tabs                                   .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I SET_DATA                      Data Transfer                                               .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I SET_FCODE                     Transfer Function Codes to Add-On                           .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_ADD_DATA_CS     I SUPPRESS_TAXI_TABSTRIPS       Hide Add-On Tab Pages                                       .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXIT            I CUSTOMER_EXIT                 Method for customer exit (RGOCODERIVE)                      .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION_CHECK I CHECK                         Integrity Check and Customer Data Mapping                   .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION_COMPL I COMPLETE                      Data Completion                                             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION_INITI I INITIALIZE                    Data Initialization                                         .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION_OUTB  I ECC_TO_EXTERN                 Data Mapping of ECC Tables to Complex Structure             .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION_UPDAT I UPDATE_MODULES                Data Update                                                 .
IF_EX_CUSTOMER_FIELDSTATUS     I CHANGE_FIELDSTATUS_INVISIBLE  Hide Fields from Screen                                     .
IF_EX_CUTX_CHECK_CHAR_STR      I CHECK_CHARS_IN_STRUCTURE      Activate: Check If All Characteristics in Table Structure   .
IF_EX_CUX_ADD_IN               I CHANGE_CONFIGURATION          Adjust External Configuration Data                          .
IF_EX_CUX_ADD_IN               I DIFFERENT_PLANT_ALLOWED       Deviating Plants Allowed (Explosion Plant and Knowledge Base.
IF_EX_CUX_ADD_IN               I FORMAT_VALUES                 Format Correction for Characteristic Value Assignment       .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_CHAR_FIRST_ASSIGNED_VALUEMethod mapped to fm CEI0_CHAR_FIRST_ASSIGNED_VALUE          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_CHANGED_TOTAL        Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_CHANGED_TOTAL                  .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_CHAR_HAS_ATTRIBUTES  Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_CHAR_HAS_ATTRIBUTES            .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_CHECK                Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_CHECK                          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_DEL_VALUE            Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_DEL_VALUE                      .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_HAS_CHARACTERISTICS  Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_HAS_CHARACTERISTICS            .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_HAS_SIMILAR_TYPE     Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_HAS_SIMILAR_TYPE               .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_HAS_TYPE             Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_HAS_TYPE                       .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_HAS_VALUES_INTERNAL  Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_HAS_VALUES_INTERNAL            .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE            Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE                      .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE_INTERNAL   Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE_INTERNAL             .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE_ONLINE     Method mapped to fm CEI0_DDB_SET_VALUE_ONLINE               .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_GET_CONDITIONS           Method mapped to fm CEI0_GET_CONDITIONS                     .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_PROCESS_AFTER_CONFIG     Method mapped to fm CEI0_PROCESS_AFTER_CONFIG               .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CEI0_SET_XAPI_MODE            Method mapped to fm CEI0_SET_XAPI_MODE                      .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_GET_STATUS_SINGLE_LEV_CFGMethod mapped to fm CE_C_GET_STATUS_SINGLE_LEV_CFG          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_HAS_CHANGES              Method mapped to fm CE_C_HAS_CHANGES                        .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_HAS_MODEL                Method mapped to fm CE_C_HAS_MODEL                          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_HAS_TYPE                 Method mapped to fm CE_C_HAS_TYPE                           .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_PROCESSING               Method mapped to fm CE_C_PROCESSING                         .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_PROCESSING_CLOSE         Method mapped to fm CE_C_PROCESSING_CLOSE                   .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_C_SET_CBASE                Method mapped to fm CE_C_SET_CBASE                          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_I_CONFIGURE                Method mapped to fm CE_I_CONFIGURE                          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_I_GET_STATUS               Method mapped to fm CE_I_GET_STATUS                         .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_I_GET_VCSD_UPDATE          Method mapped to fm CE_I_GET_VCSD_UPDATE                    .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_I_HAS_ACTUAL_INST          Method mapped to fm CE_I_HAS_ACTUAL_INST                    .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CE_I_SET_STATUS               Method mapped to fm CE_I_SET_STATUS                         .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CHECK_DELEGATION              Check delegation is active for configurable object          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CP_EX_PLAN_READ               Method mapped to fm CP_EX_PLAN_READ                         .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CS_BOM_EXPLOSION              Method mapped to fm CS_BOM_EXPLOSION                        .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CUKO_CHECK_CONFIGURATION      Method mapped to fm CUKO_CHECK_CONFIGURATION                .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CUKO_CONFIGURATION_INITIALIZERMethod mapped to fm CUKO_CONFIGURATION_INITIALIZER          .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CUKO_CONFIGURATION_TO_DB      Method mapped to fm CUKO_CONFIGURATION_TO_DB                .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CUKO_DDB_HAS_COMPONENTS       Method mapped to fm CUKO_DDB_HAS_COMPONENTS                 .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CUKO_DDB_HAS_ITEMS            Method mapped to fm CUKO_DDB_HAS_ITEMS                      .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CU_SINGLE_CFG_CHANGED         Method mapped to fm CU_SINGLE_CFG_CHANGED                   .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I CU_SINGLE_CONFIGURE           Method mapped to fm CU_SINGLE_CONFIGURE                     .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I IS_AVAILABLE                  Check if delegation is potentially used                     .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I VC_I_DISPLAY_CONFIGURATION    Method mapped to fm VC_I_DISPLAY_CONFIGURATION              .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I VC_I_GET_CONFIGURATION        Method mapped to fm VC_I_GET_CONFIGURATION                  .
IF_EX_CU_CONFIG_DELEGATION     I VC_I_GET_CONFIGURATION_IBASE  Method mapped to fm VC_I_GET_CONFIGURATION_IBASE            .
IF_EX_CVDIEXTENSION            I CVV1_FIND_RECIPIENT           Define New Recipient Types                                  .
IF_EX_CVDIEXTENSION            I CVV4_DDP_OUTPUT               DDS: Output of Packet via Communication Interface           .
IF_EX_CVI_CALL_BTE             I GET_BTE_FLAG                  Read Indicator                                              .
IF_EX_CVI_CALL_BTE             I SET_BTE_FLAG                  Set Indicator                                               .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_BP_REL_TO_CUSTOMER_CONTACTAssign BP Relationship Data to Contact Person Data          .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_BP_TO_CUSTOMER            Assign Business Partner Data to Customer Data               .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_BP_TO_CUSTOMER_CONTACT    Assign Business Partner Data to Contact Person Data         .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_BP_TO_VENDOR              Assign Business Partner Data to Vendor Data                 .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_CUSTOMER_TO_BP            Assign Customer Data to Business Partner Data               .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_CUST_CONT_TO_BP_AND_REL   Assign Contact Person Data to All Business Partner Data     .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_PERSON_TO_CUSTOMER_CONTACTAssign Person Data to Contact Person data                   .
IF_EX_CVI_CUSTOM_MAPPER        I MAP_VENDOR_TO_BP              Assign Vendor Data to Business Partner Data                 .
IF_EX_CVI_MAPPER               I MAP_BPS_TO_CUSTOMERS          Assign All Business Partner Data to Customer Data           .
IF_EX_CVI_MAPPER               I MAP_BPS_TO_VENDORS            Assign All Business Partner Data to Vendor Data             .
IF_EX_CVI_MAPPER               I MAP_CUSTOMERS_TO_BPS          Assign Customer Data to All Business Parter Data            .
IF_EX_CVI_MAPPER               I MAP_VENDORS_TO_BPS            Assign Vendor Data to All Business Partner Data             .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_BP_BANKDETAILS_TO_CUSTOMERActive: Assign Bank Details for Business Partner to Customer.
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_BP_BANKDETAILS_TO_VENDOR  Active: Assign Bank Details for Business Partner to Vendor  .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_BP_BANK_DATA_TO_CUSTOMER  Sample: Assign Bank Details for Business Partner to Customer.
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_BP_BANK_DATA_TO_VENDOR    Sample: Assign Bank Details for Business Partner to Vendor  .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_CUSTOMER_BANKDETAILS      Active: Assign Bank Details for Customer to Business Partner.
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_CUSTOMER_BANK_DATA        Sample: Assign Bank Details for Customer to Business Partner.
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_VENDOR_BANKDETAILS        Active: Assign Bank Details for Vendor to Business Partner  .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_BANKDETAILS      I MAP_VENDOR_BANK_DATA          Sample: Assign Bank Details for Vendor to Business Partner  .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_CREDIT_CARDS     I IGNORE_DUPLICATES             Ignore Verification for Duplicate Records                   .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_CREDIT_CARDS     I MAP_BP_CREDIT_CARDS           Assign Payment Cards for Business Partner to Customer       .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_CREDIT_CARDS     I MAP_CUSTOMER_CREDIT_CARDS     Assign Payment Cards for Customer to Business Partner       .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_TITLE            I MAP_CUSTOMER_TITLE_BP_CHANGE  Change BP: Assign Form of Address for Customer to BP        .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_TITLE            I MAP_CUSTOMER_TITLE_BP_CREATE  Create BP: Assign Form of Address for Customer to BP        .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_TITLE            I MAP_VENDOR_TITLE_BP_CHANGE    Change BP: Assign Form of Address for Vendor to BP          .
IF_EX_CVI_MAP_TITLE            I MAP_VENDOR_TITLE_BP_CREATE    Create BP: Assign Form of Address for Vendor to BP          .
IF_EX_CX_OFFSET_CALID          I CHANGE_CALID                  Change Calendar for Scheduling Positive/Negative Lead Time  .
IF_EX_CYMP_MODIFY_DISPLAY      I CHANGE_DISPLAY_TABLE          Change Personnel Resources Display                          .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_ASSEMBLY_COSTING           At Beginning of Costing an Object                           .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_BOM_EXPLOSION              Structure Explosion of Costing Object                       .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_COSTING_HEADER_CREATE      At End of Costing an Object                                 .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_ITEM_CREATE                Creating Items of Itemization                               .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_ITEM_VALUATE               Costing Items of Itemization                                .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_MARKING                    Marking Cost Estimate (not yet realized)                    .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_MATERIAL_SELECTION         Selecting Costing Object                                    .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_CK        I ON_RELEASING                  Releasing Cost Estimate (not yet realized)                  .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_RW        I ADD_DATA                      Fill/Change Appended Fields                                 .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_RW        I ADD_FIELDCAT                  Add To Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_RW        I ADD_HEADER_DATA               Change report header data                                   .
IF_EX_DATA_EXTENSION_RW        I ADD_SPECIAL_GROUP             Create Special Groups to Group New Fields                   .
IF_EX_DC_ASSIGNMENT_RFW        I ADD_ASSIGNMENT                Create BADI for Assignment                                  .
IF_EX_DC_ASSIGNMENT_RFW        I REMOVE_ASSIGNMENT             Delete BADI for Assignment                                  .
IF_EX_DC_ASSIGNMENT_RFW        I SAVE                          Save Assignments                                            .
IF_EX_DC_DETAIL_RFW            I CHANGE_DETAILS                Change details                                              .
IF_EX_DC_DETAIL_RFW            I CHECK_DETAILS_ALLOWED         Check if detail comparison allowed                          .
IF_EX_DC_DETAIL_RFW            I GET_DETAILS                   Get details                                                 .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Nodes                                                .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I DELETE_EDGE                   Delete Link                                                 .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I DELETE_NODE                   Delete node                                                 .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I ENUMERATE_NODES_OF_GRAPH      Number Node Table Nodes Sequentially                        .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I GET_NODETYPES                 Get Node Types                                              .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I GET_NODETYPE_FOR_NEW_NODE     Get Node Category for New Nodes                             .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I INSERT_NODE                   Create nodes                                                .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I READ_GRAPH                    Get Graph                                                   .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I RELOAD_NODE                   Reload Node Attributes                                      .
IF_EX_DC_GRAPH_RFW             I SAVE                          Store Graph Changes                                         .
IF_EX_DELGRP01                 I GET_NUMBER                    Control Number Assignment for Outbound Delivery Group       .
IF_EX_DELIVERY_ADDR_SAP        I CHANGE_DELIVERY_ADDRESS       Change General Delivery Interface                           .
IF_EX_DELIVERY_PUBLISH         I PUBLISH_AFTER_SAVE            Publication of Delivery After Saving                        .
IF_EX_DELIVERY_PUBLISH         I PUBLISH_BEFORE_COMMIT         Publication of Delivery After DB Update Before Commit       .
IF_EX_DERIVATION               I BWU_LIST_CALL_AFTER           After Call of Batch Where-Used List                         .
IF_EX_DERIVATION               I BWU_LIST_CALL_BEFORE          Before Call of Batch Where-Used List                        .
IF_EX_DERIVATION               I GOODS_MVMNTS_CALL_DECISION    In the Goods Movement: Decision Whether Derivation is Called.
IF_EX_DERIVATION               I RECIPIENT_VALUES_AND_STATUS   Manipulate Results of Derivation (per Attribute) and Status .
IF_EX_DERIVATION               I SENDER_VALUES_CHANGE          Change/Set Sender Values                                    .
IF_EX_DFPS_ABRV                I ABRV_ARCH_FREI_CHK            ABRV Check on Status Switch in Dec. System                  .
IF_EX_DFPS_ABRV                I FCODE_WIAR_CHECK              Set Back In Processing, ABRV Check in Dec. System           .
IF_EX_DFPS_ABRV                I K_OBJECT_REORG_CHECK          ABRV Check on Completion in Dec. System                     .
IF_EX_DFPS_ABRV                I USER_EXIT_ABRV                ABRV Generation in Central System                           .
IF_EX_DFPS_ACTION_LOG_EXT      I ADD_STATUS_DATA               Determine Additional Status Data for Action Log             .
IF_EX_DFPS_ALM_IQS1            I BUFFER_UPD                    Buffer Update                                               .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_CONFIRMATION_COL        Additional Authorization Checks for Collective Confirmation .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_CONFIRMATION_COL_PROP   Additional Authoriz. Checks for Collective Confirm. Proposal.
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_CONFIRMATION_IND        Additional Authoriz. Checks for Individual Confirmation     .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_EQUI                    Additional Authorization Checks for Equipment               .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_FLOC                    Additional Authorization Checks for Functional Locations    .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_FLOC1                   Addnl Ck for Functional Locations When Inheriting Reference .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_FLOC2                   Addnl Ck for Functional Locations When Inheriting Reference .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_IMPT                    Additional Authorization Checks for Meas. Points/Documents  .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_IMPT2                   Addnl Ck for Measurement Points When Inheriting Reference   .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_IMPT3                   Add. Auth. Checks When Meas. Pt Is Created (Obj. Exist?)    .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_NOTIFICATION            Additional Authorization Checks for Notification            .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_NOTIFICATION_CHANGE_VA  OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_ORDER                   Additional Authorization Checks for PM Order                .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_ORDER3                  Addnl Auth Ck: PM Ord/Nec. for New Dev. "Simple Order View" .
IF_EX_DFPS_AUTH_CHECK_PM       I CHECK_ORDER_CHANGE_VA         OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_FL_ORDER_CHECK      I FLIGHT_ORDER_CHECK            Checks Order Type                                           .
IF_EX_DFPS_IQS6                I MAP2E_WQMFE_BAPI2080_NOTITEME Mapping of WQMFE to BAPI2080_NOTITEME                       .
IF_EX_DFPS_IQS6                I MAP2E_WQMMA_BAPI2080_NOTACTVE Mapping of WQMMA to BAPI2080_NOTACTVE                       .
IF_EX_DFPS_IQS6                I MAP2E_WQMSM_BAPI2080_NOTTASKE Mapping of WQMSM to BAPI2080_NOTTASKE                       .
IF_EX_DFPS_IQS6                I MAP2E_WQMUR_BAPI2080_NOTCAUSE Mapping of WQMUR to BAPI2080_NOTCAUSE                       .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I IP02_AUTH_CHECK               OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I IP05_AUTH_CHECK               OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I IP19_AUTH_CHECK               IP19: Check Whether Maintenance Item Is Active in System    .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I MESSAGE_TOO_MANY_MPOS         OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I MPLA_AUTH_CHECK               Check Whether Maintenance Plan Is Active in System          .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I MPLA_MPOS_AUTH_INSERT         Add PM_CP Change Auth. When Creating Maintenance Plan/Item  .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I MPLA_MPOS_SELECT_AUTH_INSERT  Call RIMPOS00 When Assigning Item to Plan: Chk Change Auth? .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I MPOS_AUTH_CHECK               Check Whether Maintenance Item Is Active in System          .
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I SCHEDULING_AUTH_CHECK         OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I SCHEDULING_CANCEL             OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I SCHEDULING_CUA_STATUS_BU      OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_MAINTPLAN_CHECK     I SCHEDULING_LOCK               OBSOLETE (Req. Due to Temp. Offset: Retrofit ERP2005/EA-DFS).
IF_EX_DFPS_NOTIF_NO            I EXTERNAL_NUMBER_SET           Adopt External Notification Number                          .
IF_EX_DFPS_NUMBER_SET          I NOTIF_EXTERNAL_NUMBER_SET     Adopt External Notification Number                          .
IF_EX_DFPS_NUMBER_SET          I ORDER_EXTERNAL_NUMBER_SET     Adopt External Order Number                                 .
IF_EX_DFPS_ORDERID             I EXTERNAL_NUMBER_SET           Adopt External Order Number                                 .
IF_EX_DFPS_ORDER_CONFIRM_S     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport Data from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_DFPS_ORDER_CONFIRM_S     I PROCESS_OK_CODE               Process OK Code for Subscreen                               .
IF_EX_DFPS_ORDER_CONFIRM_S     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data to Screen                                    .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I CHANGE_FLAG_CHECK_NOTIFICATIONChecks for Changes on Saving                                .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I CUSTOMIZING_CHK_ORDER         Check whether TST Active in Customizing                     .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I EQUI_CHANGE_ME_CHECK_NOTI     Checks Change to Ref. Object with Active Technical Status   .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I FCODE_HANDLER_NOTIFICATION    Function Code Processing for Notification                   .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I FCODE_HANDLING_ORDER          FCode Processing                                            .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I FLIGHT_PUSBUTTONS             Handles Activation of Functions for Flight in Order         .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I INIT_SCREEN_NOTIFICATION      Initization of Screen for Notification                      .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I ME_CHG_CHK_NOTIFICATION       Check for Same Master Equipment for Selection from List     .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I ME_CHG_CHK_ORDER              Check for Same Master Equipment for Change                  .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I NOTIFICATION_CHECK_TECO       Checks whether Active Technical Status Exists               .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I PUT_DATA_PBO_NOTIFICATION     Transfer of Status Texts for Screen                         .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I PUT_DATA_PBO_OPERATION        Transfer of Status Texts for Screen                         .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I PUT_DATA_PBO_ORDERHEADER      Transfer of Status Texts for Screen                         .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I SWITCH_NUMBER_LO              Generates Status Object Number for TST in Notification      .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I SWITCH_NUMBER_LV              Generates Status Object Number for TST in Order Transact.   .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TECO_CHECK_NOTIFICATION       Checks whether Active Technical Status Exists               .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TECO_CHECK_NOTIFICATION_OL    Checks whether Active Technical Status Exists (Object List) .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TECO_CHECK_ORDER              Checks whether Active Technical Status Exists               .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TST_ON_ME_SET_NOTIFICATION    Changes Technical Status for Master Equipment               .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TST_OPR_STATUS_CHG            Checks for Active Tech. Sts for Status Change in Operation  .
IF_EX_DFP_TST                  I TST_VB_ORDER                  Order: Update Handling TST                                  .
IF_EX_DIESD_EMFOR              I CONTROL_SELECTION             Select Control Records                                      .
IF_EX_DIESD_EMFOR              I DATA_SELECTION                Select Data Records                                         .
IF_EX_DIFF_KEY_PRE_SET         I AFTER_GENERATION              After Generating the Assignment Set Types                   .
IF_EX_DIFF_KEY_PRE_SET         I BEFORE_GENERATION             Before Generating the Assignment Set Types                  .
IF_EX_DIFF_KEY_PRE_SET         I DELETE_ADD_OBJECTS            Deletion of Additional Objects in the Assignment Set Type   .
IF_EX_DIFF_KEY_PRE_SET         I ROLLBACK_GENERATION           Rollback Because of Error During Generation                 .
IF_EX_DIMSP_MPLAN_DETAILS      I READ_DATES_AND_COUNTERS       Read Dates and Counter Values                               .
IF_EX_DIMSP_SELECT_MPLAN       I SEL_MPLAN_FOR_APO_PLANNING_MSPSelect Maintenance Plans for MSP in SCM                     .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001             I EXIT_SAPLAD13_001             Change Texts for DI Structuring                             .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001             I EXIT_SAPLAD15_001             Change Object List and Hierarchy                            .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001_FLD         I EXIT_SAPLAD13_002             Node Typing for Single Values                               .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001_FLD         I EXIT_SAPLAD13_003             Change Characteristic Value Text                            .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001_INT         I EXIT_SAPLAD13_001             Change Texts for DI Structuring                             .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010001_INT         I EXIT_SAPLAD15_001             Change Object List and Hierarchy                            .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010002             I EXIT_SAPLAD15_010             Source Filter (Not Available For All Sources)               .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010002_INT         I EXIT_SAPLAD1C_002             Change COSEL                                                .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010002_SEL         I EXIT_SAPLAD1C_002             Change COSEL                                                .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010003_DC          I EXIT_SAPLAD12_004             Enhancement to Fill User-Defined Dependent Characteristics  .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010003_IC          I EXIT_SAPLAD12_003             Enhancement to Fill User-Defined Independent Characteristics.
IF_EX_DIP_AD010005             I EXIT_SAPLAD15_005             Read User-Defined Sources                                   .
IF_EX_DIP_AD010007             I EXIT_SAPLAD15_015             Change DI Processing Information                            .
IF_EX_DIP_ALLOW_STATUS_OBJ     I SET_SD_STATUS_OBJECT_ALLOWED  Enable DIP for Sales Documents with Status Object           .
IF_EX_DIP_CHARACT_SEQUENCE     I CHANGE_CHARACTERISTIC_SEQUENCEChange Sequence of Characteristics                          .
IF_EX_DIP_CHECK_INPUT_OBJ      I CHECK_SALES_ORDER_ITEM        Check Sales Document Item                                   .
IF_EX_DIP_CHECK_INPUT_OBJ      I CHECK_SERVICE_ORDER           Check Service Order                                         .
IF_EX_DIP_CREATE_FOLLOW_UP     I CREATE_FOLLOW_UP_SALES_DOC    Create Follow-Up Document or Extend Existing Document       .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_GUI        I CHANGE_DYNPRO_TITLE           Change Screen Title if Integraion of Billing Plan Is Active .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_GUI        I FILL_AUART_DPR                Fill Sales Document Type for Down Payment Request           .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_GUI        I GUI_FCODE_MODIFY              Adjust Function Code if Integration of Billing Plan Is Act. .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_GUI        I GUI_HANDLE_MENU               Processing of Menu/Function Codes in the DIP GUI            .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_GUI        I GUI_POPUPTEXT_MODIFY          Create Change Texts for Confirmation Prompt Document        .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I FILL_SD_INTERFACE             Fills Header for Sales and Distribution Document            .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I FLOW_WRITE_DPR                Writes Document Flow for Down Payment Request               .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I MODIFY_PDOC                   Add Additional Data to Saved Data                           .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I SCHEDULE_READ_VBELN           Read/Evaluate Billing Plan for Document/Items               .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I SCHEDULE_READ_VPKID           Read/Evaluate Billing Plan for Existing Calculation         .
IF_EX_DIP_DPBP_RRDP_PROC       I SET_BP_STATUS_BILLED          Set Status in Billing Plan to 'Billed'                      .
IF_EX_DIP_FILTER_OLD_DLIS      I CHECK_DLI                     Check Dynamic Item                                          .
IF_EX_DIP_FM_MULTIFUND         I VBAP_CHECK                    Check VBAP                                                  .
IF_EX_DIP_GET_SEL_DATA         I GET_SELECTION_DATA            Transfer Selection Data to Other Program                    .
IF_EX_DIP_INFLUENCE_GUI        I SET_MODE_CONDITION_SCREEN     Set the Processing Mode for the Condition Screen            .
IF_EX_DIP_INFLUENCE_GUI_IN     I SET_MODE_CONDITION_SCREEN     Set the Processing Mode for the Condition Screen            .
IF_EX_DIP_SALES_ITEMS_TEXT     I FILL_TEXT_TABLE               Fill Item-Text Table for DP90                               .
IF_EX_DIP_SET_SD_DIALOG        I SET_SD_DIALOG_POPUPS          Activate Dialog Boxes in SD Sales Document                  .
IF_EX_DIP_SET_USERSETTINGS     I DEFINE_NON_ALTERABLE_SETTINGS Define Non-Alterable User Settings                          .
IF_EX_DIP_SET_USERSETTINGS     I SET_USER_SETTINGS             Set User Settings                                           .
IF_EX_DIP_SET_USERSETT_INT     I DEFINE_NON_ALTERABLE_SETTINGS Define Non-Alterable User Settings                          .
IF_EX_DIP_SET_USERSETT_INT     I SET_USER_SETTINGS             Set User Settings                                           .
IF_EX_DIP_UPDATE_FKDAT         I UPDATE_FKDAT                  Transfer Updated Billing Date                               .
IF_EX_DIST_MAIN01              I D100_BEFORE_INIT_SCREEN       Before the initialization of screen 100                     .
IF_EX_DIST_MAIN01              I D100_BEFORE_PAI               Before the actual PAI of screen 100                         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NAV_REVISION       I ADD_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION_KEYS    Add customer specific function keys                         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NAV_REVISION       I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_FCODES       Process customer specific fcodes                            .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NAV_REVISION       I REVIS_SELECT_DATA             Process customer specific selection                         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NAV_REVISION       I REVIS_SET_FIELDCAT1           Modify the fields of the column area of the navigation area .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTIF_ACTION       I ACTION                        Follow-up action                                            .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTIF_ACTION       I CHECK                         Check notication action                                     .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTI_ASSIGN        I NOTI_ASSIGN_CHECK             Additional check when assigning a notification to a revision.
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTI_ASSIGN        I NOTI_DEASSIGN_CHECK           Additional check when deassigning a noti from a revision    .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTI_ASSIGN        I RO_NOTI_ASSIGN_CONTROL        Control notification assignment to revision order           .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NOTI_SELECT        I SELECTION_FROM_REVISIONS      Notification Selection from Revision                        .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NW_ASSIGN          I NETWORK_ASSIGN                Enhancement When Network is Assigned                        .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NW_ASSIGN          I NETWORK_ASSIGN_CHECK          Additional Check if Network Assignment is Allowed.          .
IF_EX_DIWPS_NW_CREATE          I DETERMINE_STD_NETWORK         Determine Standard Network Based on the Revision            .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER              I PRINT_ORDER                   Printing of orders within a Revision                        .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I CONFIGURATION_SET             Replace the default conf object to be used for TLH explosion.
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I DETERMINE_ORDER_UPDATES       Replace the default MEB for determining order updates       .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I FILL_PARAM_ORDER_GENER        Fill or replace parameters for standard orders generation   .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I ORDERS_CREATE                 Replace the Default MEB for Order Creation                  .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I TLH_EXCLUSION                 Replace the default MEB TLH exclusion functionality         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_ORDER_CREATE       I TLH_EXPLOSION_UPDATE          Update or replace the default MEB TLH explosion             .
IF_EX_DIWPS_PMPS               I PM_PS_FIELD_COMP              Comparing the PM Order Ref with the PS Activity Ref         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_PMPS               I PM_PS_FIELD_COMP_ACTIVATE     Activates the coding in the PM_PS_FIELD_COMPARISON          .
IF_EX_DIWPS_REV_CHECK          I REV_CLOSE_CHECK               Non-standard checks when closing a revision                 .
IF_EX_DIWPS_REV_CHECK          I REV_PROJ_ASSIGN_CHECK         Non-standard checks when assigning a project to a revision  .
IF_EX_DIWPS_REV_CHECK          I REV_RELEASE_CHECK             Non-Standard Checks When Releasing a Revision               .
IF_EX_DIWPS_REV_CHECK          I REV_WC_CHANGE_CHECK           Non-standard checks when changing work center of a revision .
IF_EX_DIWPS_REV_SAVE_EVT       I SEND_REV_CHANGE_EVT           Send an Event for each changed revision                     .
IF_EX_DIWPS_SLOT_UPDATE        I SLOT_DATA_UPDATE              Change data displayed on slot                               .
IF_EX_DIWPS_STATUS_ICONS       I GET_NOTIFICATION_STATUS       Gets the status icon of a notification                      .
IF_EX_DIWPS_STATUS_ICONS       I GET_ORDER_STATUS              Gets the status icon of a notification                      .
IF_EX_DIWPS_STATUS_ICONS       I GET_REVISION_STATUS           Gets the status icon of a revision                          .
IF_EX_DIWPS_STATUS_ICONS       I SET_LEGEND                    Sets the legend to display                                  .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_NOT_LIST        I ADD_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION_KEYS    Add customer specific function keys                         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_NOT_LIST        I MODIFY_FIELDCATALOG           Modify the fields of the column area of the revision tree   .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_NOT_LIST        I MODIFY_FIELDS                 Modifies the values in the fields of a notification         .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_NOT_LIST        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_FCODES       Process customer specific fcodes                            .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_REVISION        I ADD_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION         Add Customer Function                                       .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_REVISION        I MODIFY_FIELDCATALOG           Change Field Catalog of Revision Work Areas                 .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_REVISION        I MODIFY_FIELDS                 Modify or Add Fields                                        .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_REVISION        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION     Process Customer Function                                   .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WA_SLOT            I CHANGE_SLOT_TEXT              Change network slot text                                    .
IF_EX_DIWPS_WPS2               I SET_VARIANT_DEFAULT           Set Default Selection Variant for WPS2                      .
IF_EX_DI_ALE_MV_INPUT          I FILL_MARA                     Supply of specific DI fields in the table MARA              .
IF_EX_DI_ALE_MV_INPUT          I FILL_MARC                     Supply of specific DI fields in the table MARC              .
IF_EX_DI_ALE_MV_INPUT          I FILL_MATERIALID               Supply of specific DI fields in the table MATERIALID        .
IF_EX_DI_ALE_MV_INPUT          I MARA_MATERIALID_MARC_INFO     Supply of DI fields in MARA, MARC and MATERIALID            .
IF_EX_DI_MOVEMENTYPES          I GET_CUST_DEF_KEY              Get customer defined key for table ditcoko                  .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_NOTIF_ASSIGN            After Notification Assignment                               .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_NOTIF_DEASSIGN          After Notification Deassignment                             .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_REVISION_CHANGE         After Revision Change                                       .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_REVISION_CREATE         After Revision Creation                                     .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_REVISION_DELETE         After Revision Deletion                                     .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_REVISION_SELECT         After Revision Selection                                    .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I AFTER_SAVE                    After Saving                                                .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_NOTIF_ASSIGN           Before Notification Assignment                              .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_NOTIF_DEASSIGN         Before Notification Deassignment                            .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_REVISION_CHANGE        Before Revision Change                                      .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_REVISION_CREATE        Before Revision Creation                                    .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_REVISION_DELETE        Before Revision Deletion                                    .
IF_EX_DI_MSP_CIF_INBOUND       I BEFORE_SAVE                   Before Saving                                               .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_CONVERT_TASKL     I DETERMINE_OPERATION_VALUES    Reset default values & activity type for operations         .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_CONVERT_TASKL     I GET_CONVERT_INDICATOR         Central task list conversion via standard transactions      .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_CONVERT_TASKL     I GET_HDR_CONVERT_IND           Central task list conversion for order header               .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_PLANT_STORLOC     I CHANGE_PLANT_STORLOC          Central task list conversion - plant/storage location data  .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_PLAN_EXT_DATE     I GET_EXT_DATE                  Reference Date for Further Scheduling                       .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_PLAN_EXT_DATE     I GET_EXT_TIMESTAMP_START       Default Time for Start/Restart/Start in Cycle               .
IF_EX_DI_WPS_PURCH_DATA        I CHANGE_PURCH_DATA             Central task list conversion - change purchasing data       .
IF_EX_DLP_COMPONENT_FILTER     I AT_SELECTION                  Component Selection for Delivery from Project               .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_01             I MODIFY_OUTPUT_FILE            Processing of Results Table in Function Module DMEE_END     .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_01_ABA         I MODIFY_OUTPUT_FILE            Processing of Results Table in Function Module DMEE_END     .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOMING       I MODIFY_FILE_INPUT             Modification of Incoming File Before Start of Processing    .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOMING       I MODIFY_FILE_OUTPUT            Modification of Results Tables After Processing             .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOMING       I SPECIAL_RULE                  Special Logic for Determination of Relevant Segment         .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOM_ABA      I MODIFY_FILE_INPUT             Modification of Incoming File Before Start of Processing    .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOM_ABA      I MODIFY_FILE_OUTPUT            Modification of Results Tables After Processing             .
IF_EX_DMEE_BADI_INCOM_ABA      I SPECIAL_RULE                  Special Logic for Determination of Relevant Segment         .
IF_EX_DML_APPROVAL             I FILL_DELTA_STRUCTURE          Fill structure with changes that need to be approved        .
IF_EX_DML_ARCHIVING            I DELETE_DATA_FROM_DB           Delete Data from Database                                   .
IF_EX_DML_ARCHIVING            I PUT_DATA_TO_FILE              Write Data from Registered Tables to Archive                .
IF_EX_DML_ARCHIVING            I REGISTER_MODEL                Enhance Object Model with Tables                            .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Additional Authorization Check                              .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_CHANGE_START            Check Before Start of Processing (Create & Change)          .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_DELETION                Check During Deletion                                       .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_HEADER                  Check header data                                           .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_HIERARCHY               Check Hierarchy Data                                        .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_POSTING                 Check Before Saving                                         .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK                I CHECK_STATUS                  Check Status                                                .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK_RELTYPE        I CHECK_RELATIONS               Relationships Check                                         .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK_SETTYPE        I CHECK_SETTYPES                Check Set Types                                             .
IF_EX_DML_CHECK_SETTYPE        I CHECK_TEXTS                   Check Texts for Set Types                                   .
IF_EX_DML_CONVERT              I EXT_TO_INT                    Conversion of Header Data into Internal Format              .
IF_EX_DML_CONVERT              I INT_TO_EXT                    Conversion of Header Data into External Format              .
IF_EX_DML_CONVERT_SETTYPE      I CONVERT_TO_EXT                Conversion Set Types -" External                            .
IF_EX_DML_CONVERT_SETTYPE      I CONVERT_TO_INT                Conversion Set Types -" Internal                            .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I CONVERT_FROM_DB               Convert table from database format to MDF                   .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I CONVERT_TO_DB                 Convert table from MDF to database format                   .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I DELETE                        Perform DELETE yourself                                     .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I GET_TABLENAME                 Determine table name in external database                   .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I INSERT                        Perform INSERT yourself                                     .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I MODIFY                        Perform MODIFY yourself                                     .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I SELECT                        Perform SELECT yourself                                     .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I SWITCH_DELETE                 Reformulate DELETE                                          .
IF_EX_DML_DB_PROXY             I SWITCH_SELECT                 Reformulate SELECT                                          .
IF_EX_DML_DISTRIBUTION         I CHANGE_INBOUND_MESSAGE        Change to the Inbound Message                               .
IF_EX_DML_DISTRIBUTION         I CHANGE_OUTBOUND_MESSAGE       Change eto the Outbound Message                             .
IF_EX_DML_DISTRIBUTION         I USE_API_DIRECTLY              Call API directly, do not use staging                       .
IF_EX_DML_STARTUP              I CLASS_CONSTRUCTION            Class Constructor of the DML-Engine Is Running              .
IF_EX_DML_WHERE_USED           I WHERE_USED_LIST               Determine Uses                                              .
IF_EX_DNO_AUTHORITH_CHECK      I AUTH_CHECK_C                  Authorization Check at Notification Creation                .
IF_EX_DNO_AUTHORITH_CHECK      I AUTH_CHECK_E                  Authorization Check in Notification Transactions            .
IF_EX_DNO_CHANGEDOC            I CD_SELECT                     Read Change Documents                                       .
IF_EX_DNO_COMPONENTS           I DEFINE_COMPONENT_STRUCT       Transfer of Application Component Hierarchy                 .
IF_EX_DNO_COMPONENTS           I DEFINE_F4                     Customer-Specific F4 Help for Components                    .
IF_EX_DNO_EVENT_SAVE           I CHANGE_NOTIF                  Event 'Save' When Changing Notification                     .
IF_EX_DNO_EVENT_SAVE           I CREATE_NOTIF                  Event 'Save' When Creating Notification                     .
IF_EX_DNO_NOTE                 I DISPLAY_NOTE                  Display SAP Note                                            .
IF_EX_DNO_PARTNER              I CHECK_PARTNER                 Check if Partner Exists                                     .
IF_EX_DNO_PARTNER              I GET_DEST_PARTNER              Determine RFC Destination for Partner Storage Data          .
IF_EX_DNO_PARTNER              I READ_PARTNER                  Read Partner Details                                        .
IF_EX_DNO_PARTNER              I SEARCH_PARTNER                Search for Partner                                          .
IF_EX_DNO_PRIORITY_CALC        I CALCULATE_TSTMP               Calculation of Time Stamps (Initial Reaction/End of Process).
IF_EX_DNO_RFC_DATA             I CHANGE_DESTINATION            Change Destination: DNO_UPDATE                              .
IF_EX_DNO_RFC_DATA             I CHANGE_RFC_DATA               Change RFC Data: Partner and Destination                    .
IF_EX_DNO_SAP_CHECK_SAVE       I CHECK                         Check for Commit in F.Module DNO_OW_CREATE_NOTIFICATION     .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_AUTH01          I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Additional Authorization Check                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_AUTH02          I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Additional Authorization Check                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_BROWSER         I ENTRY_SCREEN                  Initializes Browser for Initial Screen of CV01/2/3N         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_BROWSER         I GET_SCREEN_FOR_SEARCH         Initializes Browser for Search Screen; Gives Subscreen Info .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_BROWSER         I GET_SCREEN_FOR_TAB            Initializes Browser for CV0xN Tab; Gives Subscreen Info     .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_CURX            I IF_REPLICABLE_DOC             Check Replicable Document                                   .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_ECL01           I BEFORE_LIST_DOCS_TO_ADD       Before Call of CV117_DOCFILES_SHOW_LIST_TREE                .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_ECL01           I SHOW_DOC_META_DATA            Display Metadata in EAI Viewer                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I AFTER_ASSIGN_FILE             After Assigning an Original                                 .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I AFTER_COPY_FILE_DIALOG        After Dialog Box for Copying the File Appears               .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I AFTER_START_APPL              After Starting the Application                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I BEFORE_ASSIGN_FILE            Before Assignment of an Original                            .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I BEFORE_COPY_FILE_DIALOG       Before Showing the Dialog Box "To Copy"                     .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I BEFORE_LIST_TEMPLATES         Before Displaying Templates                                 .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I BEFORE_START_APPL             Before Starting the Application                             .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I GENERATE_COPY_FILE_NAME       Generate File Name for Originals that are not Stored        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_FILES01         I GENERATE_ORIGINAL_FILE_NAME   Genereate a File Name when Created                          .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I AFTER_CHANGE_NUMBER_CHECK     After Validation of the Change Number                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I AFTER_DETERMINE_VALID_VERSION After Determining the Valid Version                         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I AFTER_READ_DATA               After Reading the Document Data                             .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I AFTER_SAVE                    After Saving the Document Data                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I AFTER_SEARCH_DATA             After search and before displaying data in CV04N            .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I ASSIGN_NUMBER                 Number Assignment                                           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I BEFORE_DELETE                 Before Setting the Deletion Indicator                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I BEFORE_READ_DATA              Before Reading the Document Data                            .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN01          I BEFORE_SAVE                   Before Saving the Document Data                             .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D100_BEFORE_PAI               Before the Actual PAI from Screen 100                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D100_PAI_CU1                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 1 (+D100_CU1) Screen 100           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D100_PAI_CU2                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 1 (+D100_CU2) Screen 100           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D100_PAI_CU3                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 1 (+D100_CU3) Screen 100           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_AFTER_INIT_SCREEN        After Setting Screen Status and Screen Title                .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_AFTER_PBO                After PBO Screen 101                                        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_AFTER_READ_CUST          After Reading Customizing                                   .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_BEFORE_LEAVE_TA          Before Leaving the Transaction                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_BEFORE_PAI               Before the Actual PAI from Screen 101                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_PAI_CU1                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 1 (+D100_CU1) Screen 101           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_PAI_CU2                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 2 (+D100_CU2) Screen 101           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_MAIN02          I D101_PAI_CU3                  PAI for Menu Enhancement 3 (+D100_CU3) Screen 101           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCNUMBER_CHECK               Exit for document number                                    .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCPART_CHECK                 Exit for document part                                      .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCPART_SHOW_LIST             List of all Partial Documents                               .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCVERSION_CHECK              Exit for document version                                   .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCVERSION_GET_LAST           Determine last version number                               .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCVERSION_GET_NEXT           Determine next version number                               .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_NUMBER01        I DOCVERSION_SHOW_LIST          List of All Versions                                        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I BEFORE_EXECUTE_FUNCTION       Called Before Call of Function                              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I DELETE_CHECK                  Check When Setting Deletion Flag for Document               .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I GET_DATA                      Get Data from Screen                                        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I GET_FIELD_LIST                Return Names and Lengths of Input Fields                    .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I GET_FUNCTION_CODE             Get Function Code After PAI                                 .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I GET_OBJECT_GUID               Add to List of Found Object Keys                            .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I JUMP_TO_SCREEN                Used for the Jump to Other Transactions                     .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I OBJECT_CHECK                  Data Check Replaces FM object_check_[object]                .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I PUT_DATA                      Set Data for Screen                                         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ             I PUT_FUNCTION_CODE             Set Function Code After PAI                                 .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OBJ1            I BEFORE_EXECUTE_FUNCTION       Called Before Call of Functions in PAI                      .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OFFINTEGR01     I AFTER_OPEN                    After Opening an Original with Office Integration           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OFFINTEGR01     I EDIT_LINK_ITEMS               Insert, Change, or Delete Links on Link Server              .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_OFFINTEGR01     I READ_CLASS                    When Reading the Classification of Office Integration       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_PROC01          I BEFORE_LIST_PROCESS           Before display the possible processes                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_PROC01          I BEFORE_LIST_STATUS            Before displaying possible status activities                .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_SEARCH01        I CHANGE_SEARCH_ORDER           Influence on Search Sequence                                .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STATUS01        I AFTER_CHANGE_STATUS           At Every Status Change                                      .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STATUS01        I BEFORE_CHECK_RELEASE          Prior to Check Whether Document Is Released                 .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STATUS01        I BEFORE_LIST_STATUS            Before Displaying Possible Statuses                         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I AFTER_CHECKIN                 After Physical Transport of the Original (Checkin)          .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I BEFORE_CHECKIN                After Physical Transport of the Original (Check in)         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I BEFORE_CHECKOUT               Before Physical Transport of the Original (Checkout)        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I BEFORE_LIST_STORAGECAT        Before Displaying Storage Categories                        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I BEFORE_PHYSICAL_CHECKIN       Immediately Before Physcial Transport of Originals (Checkin).
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I BEFORE_PHYSICAL_CHECKOUT      Immediately Before Transport of Originals (Checkout)        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_STORAGE01       I CHECKOUT                      Alternative Check Out (for example, from external DMS)      .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_SYSTEM01        I CLASS_DOC_CHECK_MODIFY        Can Document Be Processed In Classes?                       .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_SYSTEM01        I GET_FRONTEND                  Define Frontend Type                                        .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_THUMBNAIL       I GET_URL                       Change URL for Displaying Thumbnail                         .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_THUMBNAIL       I SET_TEXT                      Text Displayed with Thumbnail (Overview)                    .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_WEB01           I FILTER_FILES                  Define filter for originals (according to standard filter)  .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_WEB01           I GET_URL                       Determine URL for Checkout in WEB                           .
IF_EX_DOCUMENT_WEB02           I GET_URL                       Determine URL for Checkout in Web                           .
IF_EX_DOC_PERSONALIZE_BCS      I PERSONALIZE_DOCUMENT          Variable Replacement and Personalization of a Document      .
IF_EX_DOC_PERSONALIZE_BCS      I PERSONALIZE_PDF_DOC_PDFIF     PDF Form Personalization with PDF-Based Interface           .
IF_EX_DOC_PERSONALIZE_BCS      I PERSONALIZE_PDF_DOC_SFIF      PDF Form Personalization with Smart Forms Interface         .
IF_EX_DPBP_INFLUENCE_PROC      I CONSIDER_DATE_TO              Consider "Post by" in Selection Screen                      .
IF_EX_DPR_FINR3_CO_CALC        I CHANGE_CALCULATION_DATA       Change Costing Data                                         .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I DISPLAY_CONDITIONS            Display Conditions                                          .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I EXTEND_DELIVERY_DATA          Enhance Delivery Data                                       .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_STRUCTURES       Read Document Structure                                     .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I LOAD_DOCUMENT_DATA            Load Document Data                                          .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I PROCESS_EXTENSION             Prepare Additional Data for BAPI                            .
IF_EX_DRE_EXIT                 I PROCESS_EXTENSIONOUT          Read Additional Data from BAPI                              .
IF_EX_DS_AUTHORITY             I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_EX_DS_CONTEXT               I GET_DOCUMENT                  Loading the Document for the Dig. Sig. from the Application .
IF_EX_DYNPRO_EXTENSION_CK      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get Data from Subscreen                                     .
IF_EX_DYNPRO_EXTENSION_CK      I GET_TABSTRIP_NAME             Gets Name for Tabstrip (Default: Additional Data)           .
IF_EX_DYNPRO_EXTENSION_CK      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Supply Data to Subscreen                                    .
IF_EX_EAPS_HRKFT_EXTENSION     I BUFFER_REFRESH                Deletes Internal Buffer COKEY2                              .
IF_EX_EAPS_HRKFT_EXTENSION     I GET                           Returns Origin Number for Predefined Characteristics COKEY2 .
IF_EX_EAPS_HRKFT_EXTENSION     I INTERPRET                     Read Characteristics for Specified Origin Number COKEY2     .
IF_EX_EAPS_HRKFT_EXTENSION     I PREREAD                       Executes Pre-Read for Spec. Char. Values Through COKEY2     .
IF_EX_EAPS_HRKFT_EXTENSION     I SUBKEY2_PREREAD               Executes Pre-Read on Table COKEY2 for Spec. CO Subkeys      .
IF_EX_EASYDMS_EXT_UI           I GET_FUNCTION_LIST             Gets All Extendable Customer Functions                      .
IF_EX_EASYDMS_EXT_UI           I PROCESS_FUNCTION              Calls the Customer Functions                                .
IF_EX_EBI_PPM_ARCHIVE          I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze if Prepayment Documents Can Be Archived             .
IF_EX_EBPP_INVOICEDETAIL       I GET_INVOICE_DETAIL            Determine Detail Data for the Bill                          .
IF_EX_EBPP_USAPPLREF           I GET_PROFILES                  Determine Profile                                           .
IF_EX_EBPP_USAPPLREF           I GET_USAPPLREF                 Determine Object References                                 .
IF_EX_EBPP_USAPPLREF           I GET_USAPPLREF_TEXT            Determine Texts for Object References                       .
IF_EX_EBPP_USER_ADDRESS        I CHANGE_USER_ADDRESS           Change Address Data                                         .
IF_EX_EBPP_USER_ADDRESS        I CREATE_USER_ADDRESS           Read Address Data                                           .
IF_EX_EBPP_USER_ADDRESS        I GET_PARTNER_TEXT              Read Partner Information                                    .
IF_EX_EBPP_USER_ADDRESS        I GET_USER_ADDRESS              Read Address Data                                           .
IF_EX_ECM                      I CHANGE_GRAPH_NEW              Change Graph: New Status                                    .
IF_EX_ECM                      I ORDER_AUTHORITY               Engineering Change Order: Additional Authorization Check    .
IF_EX_ECM                      I ORDER_SAVE                    Engineering Change Order: Before Saving                     .
IF_EX_ECM                      I VALIDITY_AUTHORITY            Validity: Additional Authorization Check                    .
IF_EX_ECM                      I VALIDITY_CHECK_CHANGE         Validity: Change                                            .
IF_EX_ECM                      I VALIDITY_CHECK_STEADY         Validity: Continuity Check                                  .
IF_EX_ECM                      I VALIDITY_SAVE                 Validity: Before Saving                                     .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I BOM_ACTIVE_CHK                BOM Active in System                                        .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I DOCUMENT_ACTIVE_CHK           Documents Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I IPPE_ACTIVE_CHK               iPPE Active in System                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I MATERIAL_ACTIVE_CHK           Material Active in System                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O55_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 55 (Configuration Profile) Active in System          .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O60_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 60 (Substance) Active in System                      .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O61_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 61 (Phrase) Active in System                         .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O62_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 62 (Dangerous Goods) Active in System                .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O63_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 63 (Variant Table) Active in System                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O64_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 64 (Planning Profile) Active in System               .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O65_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 65 (Configuration Folder) Active in System           .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O66_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 66 (Material Version Validity) Active in System      .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O75_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 75 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O76_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 76 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O77_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 77 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O78_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 78 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O79_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 79 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O80_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 80 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O81_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 81 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O82_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 82 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O83_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 83 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O84_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 84 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O85_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 85 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O86_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 86 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O87_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 87 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O88_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 88 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O89_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 89 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O90_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 90 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O91_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 91 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O92_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 92 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O93_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 93 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O94_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 94 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O95_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 95 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O96_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 96 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O97_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 97 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O98_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 98 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I O99_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 99 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_ACTIVE_OBJECTS       I ROUT_ACTIVE_CHK               Task List Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_AEOI_CI              I CUST_AEOI_CI_PAI              Routine for PAI / Customer Fields for SAP Program           .
IF_EX_ECM_AEOI_CI              I CUST_AEOI_CI_PBO              Routine for PBO / Customer Fields for Customer Program      .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I ATEXT_READ                    Read Description of BOM Application                         .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I BOM_ALTERNATIVES_GET          Read Alternative BOMs for Object Management Records         .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I BOM_LI01_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 01 (BOM)                             .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I BOM_PROTOCOL_DATE_SHIFT       List Output Log: Date Shift for BOM                         .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I CALL_TRANS_BOM                Call BOM Dialog Transaction                                 .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I CALL_TRANS_CSXX               BOM Display Transactions                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I STLAN_CHK                     Check Existence of BOM Usage                                .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I STZU_MARK_FOR_BASELINE        BOM Has History Requirement Due to Baseline                 .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I STZU_TSTAMP_SET               Set Time Stamp in Table STZU                                .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I T415M_CHK                     Check Table T415M                                           .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I TCS34_UPDATE                  Adjust BOM Customizing                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_BOM_DECO             I WERKS_READ                    Read Plant                                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I ATEXT_READ                    Read Description of BOM Application                         .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I BOM_ACTIVE_CHK                BOM Active in System                                        .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I BOM_LI01_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 01 (BOM)                             .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I BOM_PROTOCOL_DATE_SHIFT       List Output Log: Date Shift for BOM                         .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I BROWSE_SINGLE_OBJECT          Browse Change Number                                        .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I CALL_TRANS_BOM                BOM Dialog Transaction Calls                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I CALL_TRANS_CSXX               BOM Display Transactions                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_CREATE                Create Digital Signature                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_DELETE                Delete Digital Signature                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_RESET                 Save Digital Signature                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_SAVE                  Save Digital Signature                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_SAVE_PREPARE          Prepare Update for Digitial Signature                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DIGSIGN_SHOW                  Display Digital Signature                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DOCUMENT_ACTIVE_CHK           Documents Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DOCUMENT_ASSIGNMENT           Maintain Document Assignment                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DOCUMENT_ASSIGNMENT_CHK       Check Existence of Document Assignment                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DOCUMENT_DIALOG               Document Management Dialog                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DOCUMENT_LI31_EXECUTE         List Output for Object 31 (Document)                        .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I DRAW_UPDATE                   Set Change Number in Document                               .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_ACTIVE_CHK               iPPE Active in System                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_AENNR_CHK                Change Number Used in iPPE                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_CUSTOMIZING_READ         Read iPPE Customizing                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_GUID_EXISTENCE_CHK       iPPE GUID Exists                                            .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_GUID_EXT_TO_INT          GUID Conversion from External to Internal                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_GUID_INT_TO_EXT          GUID Conversion from Internal to External                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_STATUS_CHK_RELKEY        iPPE Status Allows Release of Change Number                 .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_TEXT_READ                Read iPPE Description                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I IPPE_TRANSACTION_CALL         iPPE Transaction Call                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I MATERIAL_ACTIVE_CHK           Material Active in System                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I MATERIAL_LI41_EXECUTE         List Output for Object 41 (Material)                        .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O55_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 55 (Configuration Profile) Active in System          .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O55_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 55 (Configuration Profile)     .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O55_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 55 (Configuration Profile)      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O55_LI55_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 55 (Configuration Profile)           .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O55_POST                      Save Object 55 (Configuration Profile)                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O60_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 60 (Substance) Active in System                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O60_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 60 (Substance)                 .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O60_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 60 (Substance)                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O60_LI60_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 60 (Substance)                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O60_POST                      Save Object 60 (Substance)                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O61_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 61 (Phrase) Active in System                         .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O61_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 61 (Phrase)                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O61_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 61 (Phrase)                     .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O61_LI61_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 61 (Phrase)                          .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O61_POST                      Save Object 61 (Phrase)                                     .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O62_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 62 (Dangerous Goods) Active in System                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O62_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)           .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O62_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)            .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O62_LI62_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)                 .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O62_POST_CHK                  Check Update for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O63_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 63 (Variant Table) Active in System                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O64_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 64 (Planning Profile) Active in System               .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O65_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 65 (Configuration Folder) Active in System           .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O66_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 66 (Material Version Validity) Active in System      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O66_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 66 (Material Version Validity) .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O66_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 66 (Material Version Validity)  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O66_LI66_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 66 (Material Version Validity)       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O66_POST                      Save Object 66 (Material Version Validity)                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_ACTIVE_CHK                Object 75 Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 75                             .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 75                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 75: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 75                              .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_LI75_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 75                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I O75_POST                      Save Object 75                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I PDM_ADD_OBJ_TO_STACK          Add Change Number to Stack                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I PDM_SHOW_OBJ_FROM_STACK       Get Change Number from Stack                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I RCC00400_EXECUTE              Status Report for Change Number                             .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I ROUT_ACTIVE_CHK               Task List Active in System                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I ROUT_LI11_EXECUTE             List Output for Object 11 (Task List)                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I SIGN_OBJ_GET                  Determine Signature Object                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I STLAN_CHK                     Check Existence of BOM Usage                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I STZU_MARK_FOR_BASELINE        BOM Has History Requirement Due to Baseline                 .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I STZU_TSTAMP_SET               Set Time Stamp in Table STZU                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I T415M_CHK                     Check Table T415M                                           .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I TCA02_READ                    Read Task List Type Table                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I TCCS01_SET                    Adjust Settings in TCCS01 to Match System                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I TCS34_UPDATE                  Adjust BOM Customizing                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DECOUPLING           I WERKS_READ                    Read Plant                                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_CREATE                Create Digital Signature                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_DELETE                Delete Digital Signature                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_OBJ_GET               Determine Signature Object                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_RESET                 Save Digital Signature                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_SAVE                  Save Digital Signature                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_SAVE_PREPARE          Prepare Update for Digitial Signature                       .
IF_EX_ECM_DIGSIGN_DECO         I DIGSIGN_SHOW                  Display Digital Signature                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_DOC_DECO             I DOCUMENT_ASSIGNMENT           Maintain Document Assignment                                .
IF_EX_ECM_DOC_DECO             I DOCUMENT_ASSIGNMENT_CHK       Check Existence of Document Assignment                      .
IF_EX_ECM_DOC_DECO             I DOCUMENT_DIALOG               Document Management Dialog                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_DOC_DECO             I DOCUMENT_LI31_EXECUTE         List Output for Object 31 (Document)                        .
IF_EX_ECM_DOC_DECO             I DRAW_UPDATE                   Set Change Number in Document                               .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I ACTIVATE_PROTOTYPING          Activate Change Configuration/Prototype Construction        .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I CHECK_TABLE_FOR_F4            Override Check Table Input Help for Parameter Effectivity   .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I CHK_FOR_SET_RLKEY             Check when Setting Release Key in Unit                      .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I COPY_NO_STATUS                Status Profile Ignored When Copying                         .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I COPY_OLD_VERSION_ACTIVE       Activate Old Version of Copying                             .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I ECR_REJECT_CONTROL            Request: Refuse Is Active If Approve Is in Signature Process.
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I FILL_AENNR_FROM_CCNO          Go from Message to Change Number                            .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I GET_CUSTOMER_VARIANTS         Copy Customer Variants                                      .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I GET_OBJECTS_AFTER_CUST_SELECT Copy Objects According to Customer Selection                .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I OCM_IDENTICAL_OBJECT_HANDLING Restrict Inclusion of Homogeneity List                      .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I OMR_CHECK_01                  Check Object Management Record After Entry in Dialog Mode   .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I SWITCH_OF_MATDOC_CHECK        Deactivate Material/Document Check for Revision Levels      .
IF_EX_ECM_EXIT                 I TCC08_KZTPR_OVERRIDE          Indicator to Override Active Date Check                     .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_AENNR_CHK                Change Number Used in iPPE                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_CUSTOMIZING_READ         Read iPPE Customizing                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_GUID_EXISTENCE_CHK       iPPE GUID Exists                                            .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_GUID_EXT_TO_INT          GUID Conversion from External to Internal                   .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_GUID_INT_TO_EXT          GUID Conversion from Internal to External                   .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_STATUS_CHK_RELKEY        iPPE Status Allows Release of Change Number                 .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_TEXT_READ                Read iPPE Description                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_IPPE_DECO            I IPPE_TRANSACTION_CALL         iPPE Transaction Call                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_MAT_DECO             I MATERIAL_GET_INTERNAL         Reserve and Return Internal Material Numbers                .
IF_EX_ECM_MAT_DECO             I MATERIAL_LI41_EXECUTE         List Output for Object 41 (Material)                        .
IF_EX_ECM_O55_DECO             I O55_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 55 (Configuration Profile)     .
IF_EX_ECM_O55_DECO             I O55_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 55 (Configuration Profile)      .
IF_EX_ECM_O55_DECO             I O55_LI55_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 55 (Configuration Profile)           .
IF_EX_ECM_O55_DECO             I O55_POST                      Save Object 55 (Configuration Profile)                      .
IF_EX_ECM_O60_DECO             I O60_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 60 (Substance)                 .
IF_EX_ECM_O60_DECO             I O60_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 60 (Substance)                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O60_DECO             I O60_LI60_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 60 (Substance)                       .
IF_EX_ECM_O60_DECO             I O60_POST                      Save Object 60 (Substance)                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O61_DECO             I O61_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 61 (Phrase)                    .
IF_EX_ECM_O61_DECO             I O61_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 61 (Phrase)                     .
IF_EX_ECM_O61_DECO             I O61_LI61_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 61 (Phrase)                          .
IF_EX_ECM_O61_DECO             I O61_POST                      Save Object 61 (Phrase)                                     .
IF_EX_ECM_O62_DECO             I O62_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)           .
IF_EX_ECM_O62_DECO             I O62_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)            .
IF_EX_ECM_O62_DECO             I O62_LI62_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)                 .
IF_EX_ECM_O62_DECO             I O62_POST_CHK                  Check Update for Object 62 (Dangerous Goods)                .
IF_EX_ECM_O66_DECO             I O66_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 66 (Material Version Validity) .
IF_EX_ECM_O66_DECO             I O66_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 66 (Material Version Validity)  .
IF_EX_ECM_O66_DECO             I O66_LI66_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 66 (Material Version Validity)       .
IF_EX_ECM_O66_DECO             I O66_POST                      Save Object 66 (Material Version Validity)                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 75                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 75                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 75: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 75                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_LI75_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 75                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O75_DECO             I O75_POST                      Save Object 75                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 76                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 76                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 76: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 76                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_LI76_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 76                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O76_DECO             I O76_POST                      Save Object 76                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 77                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 77                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 77: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 77                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_LI77_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 77                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O77_DECO             I O77_POST                      Save Object 77                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 78                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 78                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 78: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 78                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_LI78_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 78                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O78_DECO             I O78_POST                      Save Object 78                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 79                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 79                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 79: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 79                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_LI79_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 79                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O79_DECO             I O79_POST                      Save Object 79                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 80                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 80                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 80: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 80                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_LI80_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 80                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O80_DECO             I O80_POST                      Save Object 80                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 81                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 81                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 81: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 81                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_LI81_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 81                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O81_DECO             I O81_POST                      Save Object 81                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 82                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 82                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 82: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 82                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_LI82_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 82                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O82_DECO             I O82_POST                      Save Object 82                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 83                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 83                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 83: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 83                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_LI83_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 83                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O83_DECO             I O83_POST                      Save Object 83                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 84                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 84                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 84: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 84                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_LI84_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 84                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O84_DECO             I O84_POST                      Save Object 84                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 85                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 85                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 85: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 85                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_LI85_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 85                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O85_DECO             I O85_POST                      Save Object 85                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 86                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 86                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 86: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 86                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_LI86_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 86                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O86_DECO             I O86_POST                      Save Object 86                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 87                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 87                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 87: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 87                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_LI87_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 87                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O87_DECO             I O87_POST                      Save Object 87                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 88                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 88                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 88: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 88                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_LI88_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 88                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O88_DECO             I O88_POST                      Save Object 88                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 89                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 89                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 89: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 89                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_LI89_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 89                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O89_DECO             I O89_POST                      Save Object 89                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 90                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 90                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 90: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 90                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_LI90_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 90                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O90_DECO             I O90_POST                      Save Object 90                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 91                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 91                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 91: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 91                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_LI91_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 91                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O91_DECO             I O91_POST                      Save Object 91                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 92                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 92                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 92: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 92                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_LI92_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 92                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O92_DECO             I O92_POST                      Save Object 92                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 93                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 93                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 93: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 93                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_LI93_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 93                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O93_DECO             I O93_POST                      Save Object 93                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 94                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 94                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 94: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 94                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_LI94_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 94                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O94_DECO             I O94_POST                      Save Object 94                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 95                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 95                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 95: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 95                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_LI95_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 95                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O95_DECO             I O95_POST                      Save Object 95                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 96                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 96                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 96: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 96                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_LI96_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 96                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O96_DECO             I O96_POST                      Save Object 96                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 97                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for object 97                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 97: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 97                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_LI97_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 97                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O97_DECO             I O97_POST                      Save Object 97                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 98                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 98                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 98: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 98                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_LI98_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 98                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O98_DECO             I O98_POST                      Save Object 98                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_AENNR_CHK                 Change Number Used in Object 99                             .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_ATTXT_GET                 Read Object Type Description for Object 99                  .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_CONFIGURATION_CHK         Object 99: Functional Configuration                         .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_DATE_CHK                  Check Date Shift for Object 99                              .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_LI99_EXECUTE              List Output for Object 99                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_O99_DECO             I O99_POST                      Save Object 99                                              .
IF_EX_ECM_OTHERS_DECO          I BROWSE_SINGLE_OBJECT          Browse Change Number                                        .
IF_EX_ECM_OTHERS_DECO          I PDM_ADD_OBJ_TO_STACK          Add Change Number to Stack                                  .
IF_EX_ECM_OTHERS_DECO          I PDM_SHOW_OBJ_FROM_STACK       Get Change Number from Stack                                .
IF_EX_ECM_OTHERS_DECO          I RCC00400_EXECUTE              Status Report for Change Number                             .
IF_EX_ECM_OTHERS_DECO          I TCCS01_SET                    Adjust Settings in TCCS01 to Match System                   .
IF_EX_ECM_ROUT_DECO            I ROUT_ALTERNATIVES_GET         Read Alternative Task Lists for Object Management Records   .
IF_EX_ECM_ROUT_DECO            I ROUT_LI11_EXECUTE             List Output for Object 11 (Task List)                       .
IF_EX_ECM_ROUT_DECO            I TCA02_READ                    Read Task List Type Table                                   .
IF_EX_ECM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_AT_SAVE                When daving in dialog                                       .
IF_EX_ECM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Before calling up update                                    .
IF_EX_ECM_UPDATE               I CHANGE_IN_UPDATE              In the update                                               .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I ADD_NEW_FCODE_ITEMIZATION     Item View: Add New Functions                                .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I ADD_NEW_FCODE_TREE_CM         Costing Structure (Context Menu): Add New Functions         .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I ADD_NEW_FCODE_TREE_TB         Costing Structure (Toolbar): Add New Functions              .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I AT_SUBMIT_AFTER_GENERATION    Item Generation: Change Items After Generation              .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I AT_SUBMIT_AFTER_INSERTION     Item Generation: Change Cost Estimate After Transfer        .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I AT_SUBMIT_RESOURCE_GENERATION Item Generation: After Generation of Template Resources     .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I HANDLE_FCODE_NEW_ACTUALS      Actual Reporting: Own ExecServ Displ./Change/Reverse on Line.
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I HANDLE_NEW_FCODE_ITEMIZATION  Item View: Execute New Functions                            .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I HANDLE_NEW_FCODE_TREE_CM      Costing Structure (Context Menu): Execute New Function      .
IF_EX_ECP_ADD_FUNCTIONS_CK     I HANDLE_NEW_FCODE_TREE_TB      Costing Structure (Toolbar): Execute New Function           .
IF_EX_ECP_BATCHPROCESS         I BEFORE_EXPORT_TO_DB           Modify Object Key List Before Export to the Database        .
IF_EX_ECP_PORTAL1              I AFTER_DATA_SELECT             Modify Data Selection                                       .
IF_EX_ECP_PORTAL1              I AFTER_FIELD_SELECT            Modify List of Fields Transferred to an iView               .
IF_EX_ECP_PORTAL1              I AFTER_OBJECT_KEY_SELECT       Modify Object Key List                                      .
IF_EX_ECP_PORTAL1              I ON_END_PROCESSING             Modify Data Before Transferred to Portal                    .
IF_EX_ECP_SRV_AUTHORITY_CH     I AFTER_DATA_SELECTION          after data selection include additional check               .
IF_EX_ECRM_CONTR_UPLOAD        I MOVEIN_CREATED                Follow-Up Actions for Creation of Move-In from CRM          .
IF_EX_ECRM_CRM_DOWNLOAD        I CRM_DOWNLOAD_FILL_DATA        Maintain CRM fro MDG Container                              .
IF_EX_ECRM_CRM_DOWNLOAD        I CRM_DOWNLOAD_GET_PARAMS       Maintain the Sales Data in the CRM Download                 .
IF_EX_ECRM_CRM_UPLOAD          I CRM_UPLOAD_FILL_CONTAINER     Maintain Parameter Containers in CRM - Upload               .
IF_EX_ECRM_CRM_UPLOAD          I MOVEINDATE_CHANGED            Follow-Up Actions for Move-In Date Changes                  .
IF_EX_ECRM_CRM_UPLOAD          I MOVEIN_CREATED                Follow-Up Actions for Creation of Move-In from CRM          .
IF_EX_ED_MONASN                I CHANGE_DATA                   Change Header and Item Data for Task                        .
IF_EX_ED_MONORD                I CHANGE_DATA                   Change Header and Item Data for Task                        .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I CHECK_DATA                    Semantic Check (SAVE_DATA, INSERT_DATA)                     .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I CHECK_DELETE                  Check Whether Data Record Can Be Deleted                    .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I CHECK_EDIT                    Check Whether Data Record Can Be Changed                    .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I CHECK_INSERT                  Check Whether New Data Record Can Be Created                .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I CHECK_SHOW                    Check Whether Data Record Can Be Displayed                  .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I DELETE_DATA                   Load Additional Data                                        .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I GET_BO                        Determine Business Object (Set Previously with SET_BO)      .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I INSERT_DATA                   New Data Record Was Saved (INSERT)                          .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I LOAD_DATA                     Load Additional Data                                        .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I NEW_DATA                      Prepare New Data Record (PREPARE INSERT)                    .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I SAVE_DATA                     Data Record Was Saved (UPDATE)                              .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_BASE           I SET_BO                        Announce Business Object                                    .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_DELIVBAN       I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_WDPLANT        I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BA_WDPPROC        I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I BOOKSTART                     Posting Is Started                                          .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I CANEDIT                       Is it Possible to Switch to Processing?                     .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I CANINSERT                     Can New Data Record Be Created?                             .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I CANSAVE                       Is it Possible to Save?                                     .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I DISPATCH_OK_CODE              Process OK_CODE                                             .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I GET_APP_INTERFACE             Get Interface for Application-Specific Functions            .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I GET_FRAME_INTERFACE           Get Interface for Frame                                     .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I GET_LIST_INTERFACE            Determine Additional Information for LIST                   .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I LOAD_DATA                     Data loaded                                                 .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I SAVE_DATA                     Data Saved                                                  .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_BASE           I SET_APP                       Reference to Application (CL_EEWA_FORM_BASE)                .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_DOCK           I GET_DOCK_INTERFACE            Determine Additional Information for LIST                   .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_LIST           I GET_LIST_INTERFACE            Determine Additional Information for LIST                   .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_TREE           I GET_TREE_INTERFACE            Determine Additional Interface for Tree                     .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_BD_WDPLJRNL       I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_DOCK              I INIT_OPTIONS                  Set Dock Properties                                         .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_FRAME             I SET_FRAME                     Set Frame                                                   .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_LIST              I INIT_OPTIONS                  Set List Options                                            .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_LIST              I REFRESH                       Update Additional Fields                                    .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_TREE              I ADJUST_NODES                  Adjust Tree Nodes and Items                                 .
IF_EX_EEWAEL_TREE              I INIT_OPTIONS                  Set Tree Properties                                         .
IF_EX_EEWAWA_BA_PCKGOODS       I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAWA_BA_WEIGHOFFL      I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWAWA_BA_WEIGHPROC      I GET_BASE_INTERFACE            Basis Interface for Business Object                         .
IF_EX_EEWA_ROUTE_ARCHIVE       I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze Whether Routes Can Be Archived                      .
IF_EX_EEWA_WDO_ARCHIVE         I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze Waster Disposal Orders for Archiving                .
IF_EX_EEW_BDT_ADD_NEW_FLDS     I CHANGE_GEN_OBJECTS            Changes/Adds to Non-BDT-Standard Objects for Gen. Request   .
IF_EX_EEW_BDT_ADD_NEW_TABL     I ADD_GEN_OBJECTS               Adds More Non-BDT-Standard Objects to Generation Request    .
IF_EX_EEW_BDT_ADD_NEW_TABL     I CHANGE_GEN_OBJECTS            Changes/Adds to Non-BDT-Standard Objects for Gen. Request   .
IF_EX_EFG_PRINTPARAMS          I CHANGE_IN_DIALOG_AFTER        Change to Print Parameters after Print Parameter Dialog     .
IF_EX_EFG_PRINTPARAMS          I CHANGE_IN_DIALOG_BEFORE       Change to Print Parameters before Print Parameter Dialog    .
IF_EX_EFG_PRINTPARAMS          I CHANGE_IN_PRINT_EXPANDED      Change to Print Parameters in Print Event                   .
IF_EX_EFG_SPOOL_OUTPUT         I OUTPUT_DONE                   Spool Requests Being Output                                 .
IF_EX_EFG_SPOOL_OUTPUT         I OUTPUT_STATUS                 Status of Output Requests                                   .
IF_EX_EHSB_DMS_DOCUMENT        I CHANGE_AUTHORITYGROUP         Set Authorization Group                                     .
IF_EX_EHSB_DMS_ENCODE          I DECODE                        Decrypting of User-Defined Texts                            .
IF_EX_EHSB_DMS_ENCODE          I ENCODE                        Encrypting of User-Defined Texts                            .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_ADD_CLASS_DEF             Add Application-Specific Characteristics                    .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_ADD_DATA                  Add Application-Specific Data                               .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_ALVLAYOUT                 Determine ALV Layout Structure                              .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_EXCLUDED_TOOLBAR          Determine Pushbuttons to Be Hidden                          .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_LAYOUT                    Determine ALV Layout                                        .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_OUTTAB                    Determine 'ALV Outtab' Table                                .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Determine Data for Initializing ALV Grid                    .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_VARIANT                   Affect Layout Behavior                                      .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED      Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DOUBLE_CLICK               Action on Double-Click                                      .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DRAG                       Action at Time of Drag                                      .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DROP                       Action at Time of Drop                                      .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_F1                         Action on Call of F1 Help                                   .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_F4                         Check Routine for Input Help                                .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_INIT                       Actions During Initialization                               .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add Pushbuttons to Toolbar                                  .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_USER_COMMAND               Evaluate User Action                                        .
IF_EX_EHSB_VAI_ADD_INF         I SAVE_TO_DB                    Save                                                        .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I GET_DATA_PAI                  Get Data at Event PAI                                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I GET_DATA_PBO                  Get Data at Event PBO                                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I GET_OKCODE_PAI                Get OK Code at Event PAI for Subscreen                      .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Write Data at Event PAI                                     .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Write Data at Event PBO                                     .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I PUT_OKCODE_PAI                Write OK Code at Event PAI for Main Screen                  .
IF_EX_EHSH_BC_DET_SCR          I SAVE_DATA                     Save of Changed Data                                        .
IF_EX_EHSH_EXAM_MEX_01         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 1 for Examinations                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_EXAM_MEX_02         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 2 for Examinations                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_MED_SRV_MEX_01      I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Medical Service                        .
IF_EX_EHSH_MED_SRV_MEX_02      I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Medical Service                        .
IF_EX_EHSH_MPC_INTEGRATION     I SCHEDULE_WITH_PERSON_SEARCH   Calendar with Person Search                                 .
IF_EX_EHSH_MPC_INTEGRATION     I SCHEDULE_WITH_TODO_LIST       Entry via List of Services to Be Scheduled                  .
IF_EX_EHSH_PCP_ABSENCES        I DISPLAY_ABSENCES              Display Absences of a Person                                .
IF_EX_EHSH_PCP_MEX_01          I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 1 for Planning Cockpit                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_PCP_MEX_02          I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 2 for Planning Cockpit                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_PCP_SELECT          I SELECTION_INFO                Setting of Selection Text and Icon for Person Selection     .
IF_EX_EHSH_PCP_SELECT          I SELECT_PERSONS                Person Selection for Planning Cockpit                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I GET_DATA_PAI                  Read Screen Data at Event PAI                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I GET_DATA_PBO                  Read Screen Data at Event PBO                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I OKCODE_HANDLER                OK-Code Handler                                             .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PAI                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PBO                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSDAT_SCR         I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSID_SCR          I GET_DATA_PAI                  Read Screen Data at Event PAI                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSID_SCR          I GET_DATA_PBO                  Read Screen Data at Event PBO                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSID_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PAI                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_PERSID_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PBO                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_POH_CHECK_AUTH      I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Enhanced Authorization Check                                .
IF_EX_EHSH_PROT_MEX_01         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 1 for Health Surveillance Protocols          .
IF_EX_EHSH_PROT_MEX_02         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 2 for Health Surveillance Protocols          .
IF_EX_EHSH_PROT_NEXT_CALC      I SRV_PROT_NEXT_CALC            Calculation of Next Appointment for Protocol in Service     .
IF_EX_EHSH_PROT_SUGGEST        I PROT_SUGGEST                  Customer-Specific Determination of Protocols                .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRVDIA_DET_SCR      I GET_DATA_PAI                  Get Data at Event PAI                                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRVDIA_DET_SCR      I GET_DATA_PBO                  Get Data at Event PBO                                       .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRVDIA_DET_SCR      I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Write Data at Event PAI                                     .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRVDIA_DET_SCR      I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Write Data at Event PBO                                     .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I GET_DATA_PAI_DETAIL           Read Data Subscreen Container "Header Data" Tab Page        .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I GET_DATA_PBO_DETAIL           Read Data Subscreen Dynpro "Header Data" Tab Page           .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I GET_DATA_PBO_OVERVIEW         Read Data Subscreen Dynpro "Examination" Tab Page           .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I OKCODE_HANDLER                Execute Function Codes                                      .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I PUT_DATA_PAI_DETAIL           Transfer Data Subscreen Dynpro "Header Data" Tab Page       .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I PUT_DATA_PBO_DETAIL           Transfer Data Subscreen Container "Header Data" Tab Page    .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I PUT_DATA_PBO_OVERVIEW         Transfer Data Subscreen Container "Examination" Tab Page    .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_EXA_SCR         I SAVE                          Save Changed Data                                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_FILTER          I CALL_FILTER_POPUP             Call Filter Popup Dialog                                    .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_FILTER          I READ_FILTER_VALUES            Read Filter Values                                          .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_FILTER          I SELECT_MEDICAL_SERVICES       Select Medical Service Based on Filter Values               .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_OV_SCR          I GET_DATA_PAI                  Read Screen Data at Event PAI                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_OV_SCR          I GET_DATA_PBO                  Read Screen Data at Event PBO                               .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_OV_SCR          I OKCODE_HANDLER                OK-Code Handler                                             .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_OV_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PAI                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_SRV_OV_SCR          I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PBO                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_VACC_MEX_01         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Call Menu Exit 1 for Vaccinations                           .
IF_EX_EHSH_VACC_MEX_02         I MENU_EXIT_CALL                Vaccinations - Menu Exit 2                                  .
IF_EX_EHSI_ACPM_DATA_TRANS     I NOTIFICATION_CREATE           Create Notification from IHS Safety Measure Screen          .
IF_EX_EHSI_ACPM_DATA_TRANS     I NOTIFICATION_READBACK         Read Back Notification Data to IH Safety Measures           .
IF_EX_EHSI_AC_COSTC            I COSTS_CALC                    Calculation of Safety Measure Costs                         .
IF_EX_EHSI_ANNC_RATCP          I COMPUTE_RATING                Calculation of Rating of Standardized Criteria              .
IF_EX_EHSI_ER_MEX_01           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Risk Assessment                        .
IF_EX_EHSI_ER_MEX_02           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Risk Assessment                        .
IF_EX_EHSI_ER_MEX_03           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 3 for Risk Assessment                        .
IF_EX_EHSI_ER_MEX_04           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 4 for Risk Assessment                        .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_ASS_SRV_SCR     I GET_DATA                      Read Screen Data                                            .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_ASS_SRV_SCR     I GET_OKCODE                    Read Function Code                                          .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_ASS_SRV_SCR     I PUT_DATA                      Transfer Screen Data                                        .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_ASS_SRV_SCR     I PUT_OKCODE                    Transfer Function Code                                      .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_MEX_01          I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Injury/Illness Log                     .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_MEX_02          I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Injury/Illness Log                     .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_MEX_03          I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 3 for Injury/Illness Log                     .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_MEX_04          I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 4 for Injury/Illness Log                     .
IF_EX_EHSI_FAL_MEX_1           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Injury/Illness Log                     .
IF_EX_EHSI_IA_BAPI             I TRANSFER_APITAB_2_EXTENSIONTABTransfer Data from Internal Table to Extension Table        .
IF_EX_EHSI_IA_BAPI             I TRANSFER_EXTENSIONTAB_2_APITABTransfer Data from Extension Table to Internal Table        .
IF_EX_EHSI_IA_RPHDFLG_COMP     I IAREPHDFLC_COMPUTE            Method to Determine Reportable Event Ind. in Inc./Acc. Hdr  .
IF_EX_EHSI_INT_ORG_1403        I INFTY_1403_WRITE              EHS: Write Long-Term Average to Infotype 1403               .
IF_EX_EHSI_IPEVA_TIMDAT        I ABSENCES_CHECK_CONSISTENCY    Check Absences for Consistency                              .
IF_EX_EHSI_IPEVA_TIMDAT        I ABSENCES_DIALOG_CALL          Call of Dialog Box for Multiple Absences                    .
IF_EX_EHSI_IPEVA_TIMDAT        I TIMEDATA_FROM_ABS_DETERMINE   Calculation of Overview Data for Time Data                  .
IF_EX_EHSI_MJVA_MATCHUP        I MJVA_MATCHUP                  Transfer Measured Values to Amounts                         .
IF_EX_EHSI_MJ_IMPORT           I MJ_IMPORT                     Import of Measured Values                                   .
IF_EX_EHSI_MJ_MEX_01           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Measurements                           .
IF_EX_EHSI_MJ_MEX_02           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Measurements                           .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_CREATE           I MP_CREATE                     Creation of Measurement Projects                            .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I CALL_DEVICE_DETAIL            Display Device Details                                      .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I GET_DATA_PAI                  Read Screen Data at Event PAI                               .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I GET_DATA_PBO                  Read Screen Data at Event PBO                               .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I OKCODE_HANDLER                OK-Code Handler                                             .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I PRINT_DEVICE_LIST             Print Device List                                           .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PAI                           .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Screen Data at Event PBO                           .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I SAVE                          Save Device List                                            .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_DV_SCR           I VALUE_REQUEST_DEVICE          Input Help for Devices                                      .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_EPI_IMP          I EPI_IMPORT                    Import of Exposure Profile Entries                          .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_METHOD_HELP      I METHOD_HELP                   Call Input Help for Measurement Method                      .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_MEX_01           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Measurement Projects                   .
IF_EX_EHSI_MP_MEX_02           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Measurement Projects                   .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_MEX_01           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 1 for Work Area                              .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_MEX_02           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 2 for Work Area                              .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_MEX_03           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 3 for Work Area                              .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_MEX_04           I MENUE_EXIT_CALL               Call Menu Exit 4 for Work Area                              .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_OVERALL_RAT      I GET_OVERALL_RATING            Calculation of Overall Rating for a Work Area               .
IF_EX_EHSI_WA_RECEIVED_RAT     I GET_RECEIVED_RATING           Calculation of Received Rating for Work Area                .
IF_EX_EHSS_HITLIST             I INITIALIZATION                Initialization of BAdI                                      .
IF_EX_EHSS_PROP_TREE           I DETERMINE                     Determination of Property Tree                              .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I AT_SAVE_CHECK                 Checks When Saving Specification Data                       .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I BOMBOS_BOS_DETERMINE          BOM Transfer: Determine All BOM Items                       .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I BOMBOS_GET_SPEC               BOM Transfer: Determination of Specification for Material   .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I BOMPOS_UNIT_CHECK             Check Units of Measure                                      .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I MAT_ASSIGN_CHECK              Checks for Material Assignment                              .
IF_EX_EHSS_SPEC_CHECKS         I ON_OPEN_CHECK                 Checks When Opening Specification Header                    .
IF_EX_EHSS_WWI_BADI_001        I C12LAYOUT_ACTION              Event on Buttons                                            .
IF_EX_EHSS_WWI_BADI_001        I C12LAYOUT_ACTIVATE            Capture Event on Tab Page                                   .
IF_EX_EHSS_WWI_BADI_001        I C12LAYOUT_INIT                Initializes the BAdI Object                                 .
IF_EX_EHSS_WWI_BADI_001        I C12LAYOUT_SYNCRO_DOC          Event --" Read from Word Document                           .
IF_EX_EHSS_WWI_BADI_001        I C12LAYOUT_SYNCRO_TREE         Evaluate Event in Symbol Tree                               .
IF_EX_EHSW_DISPOSAL_PAPERS     I MODIFIC_SELECTION             Modification of Result List of Standard Selection           .
IF_EX_EHSW_EN_CHECK            I AUTH_CHECK                    Authorization Check for Master Data in Disposal Processing  .
IF_EX_EHSW_MN_PRINT            I PARAMETER_GET                 Determine Parameters (Print Preview and Print)              .
IF_EX_EHSW_MN_PRINT            I PRE_PRINT                     Execute Actions Before Printing                             .
IF_EX_EHSW_MN_SAVE_TO_DB       I SAVE_ADD_DATA_TO_DB           Save Additional Data with Disposal Document Data            .
IF_EX_EHSW_WASTE_APPROVAL      I CHECK_HAZ_WASTE               Check for Hazardous Waste                                   .
IF_EX_EHS_BOMBOS               I C1L1_SUBST_READ_BY_MATNR      EHS: BOMBOS: Determine Specification for Material           .
IF_EX_EHS_DGC_001              I ENLARGE_MASTER_DATA           Extend Dangerous Goods Master Records                       .
IF_EX_EHS_DGC_002              I DG_CHK_REACT_ORDER_DETERMINE  Determine Reaction of DG Checks for Sales Documents         .
IF_EX_EHS_DGC_002              I DG_CHK_REACT_SHIPP_DETERMINE  Determine Reaction of DG Checks for Shipping Documents      .
IF_EX_EHS_DGC_002              I DG_CHK_REACT_TRANS_DETERMINE  Determine Reaction of DG Checks for Shipment Documents      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I AENNR_CHANGE                  Change Date for Change Number with Change                   .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I AENNR_CHECK                   Check Whether Date of Change Number Can Be Changed          .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I AENNR_SHOW                    Create Report on Usage of a Change Number                   .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I AENNR_USE                     Where-Used List for a Change Number                         .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I CHECK_FRAME_DELIVERY          Main Program Dangerous Goods Checks in Shipping             .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I CHECK_FRAME_SHIPMENT          Main Program Dangerous Goods Checks in Shipment             .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I CHECK_LOG_TRANS               Dialog Box Dangerous Goods Checks in Shipment Document      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I DG_CHECKS_ACTIVE              Activation Check and Check Schema Determ. for DG Checks     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I DG_CHECKS_PUSH                Activation Check for DG Checks for SD Pushbutton            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I EDI_READ_DG_DATA              General Call of Read DG Data Modules                        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD01                  Filling Segment E1EDD01                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD10                  Filling Segment E1EDD10                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD11                  Filling Segment E1EDD11                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD12                  Filling Segment E1EDD12                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD14                  Filling Segment E1EDD14                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD15                  Filling Segment E1EDD15                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD16                  Filling Segment E1EDD16                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD17                  Filling Segment E1EDD17                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I FILL_E1EDD18                  Filling Segment E1EDD18                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_COND_TEXT_KEY             Call of Hazmat_pri_cond_get and HAZMAT_GET_TEXT_KEYS        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_DG_UNDEP_TEXT             Read Text Header Data for Standard Texts                    .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_HEADER_TEXT               Read Header Data for Header Texts                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_HEADER_TEXT_TABLE         Read Header Data for Header Texts                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_ITEM_TEXT                 Read Header Data for Item Texts                             .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_ITEM_TEXT_TABLE           Read Header Data for Item Texts                             .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I GET_TRAF_CARR_CATEGORY        Description for Mode of Trans. Cat. (SINGLE-READ) from TDG66.
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_ARCHIVE_SEL            Archiving LIPSDG                                            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_DELETE                 Deletion of Record from LIPSDG                              .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_GET                    Read LIPSDG Record from Buffer                              .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_MAINTAIN               Maintenance LIPSDG                                          .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_READ                   Read LIPSDG from Database                                   .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_REFRESH                Clear LIPDG                                                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_RENAME                 Number Assignment LIPSDG                                    .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I LIPSDG_UPDATE                 Save LIPSDG to Database                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I MATNR_USE                     Usage of a Material Number in DG Material Master            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I PRI_DATA_GET                  Determination of DG Data for Output of Delivery Note        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I PROLI_DIALOG_CHECK            Individual Input Check for PROLI Field in SD Document       .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_001               I VALID_TDG41                   F4 Help for DG Indicator Profile in Material Master         .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Check Whether Template Material Processing Active           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DELETE_UCADM                  Delete DGMSD Records if Incomplete in Shipping              .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_ARCHIVE_SEL             Read DGMSD Records from Database for Archiving              .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_COPY                    Copy Table XDGMSD                                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_DELETE                  Delete a Record from XDGMSD                                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_DELETE_ITEM             Delete DGMSD Records No Longer Required (Sales)             .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_DELIVERY_DEP_READ       Read DGMSD Table from Database in Shipping                  .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_DELIVERY_READ           Read DGMSD Table from Database in Shipping                  .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_GET                     Read an XDGMSD Record from Buffer                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_ORDER_READ              Read DGMSD Table from Database in Sales                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_REFRESH                 Clear Table DGMSD                                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_RENAME                  Number Assignment for Table DGMSD                           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_UPDATE                  Update of Table DGMSD                                       .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I DGMSD_VBUV_UPDATE             Update of Table VBUV                                        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I GET_DATA_EHS                  Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I GET_FCODE                     Transfer Function Code                                      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I IDOC_INPUT_DELVRY             Unpack DG Data (Inbound) and Update DGMSD                   .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I MD_DET_DELIVERY               Determination of DG Master Data in Shipping                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I MD_DET_ORDER                  Determination of DG Master Data in Sales                    .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I SET_DATA_SD                   Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I SET_FCODE                     Transfer Function Code                                      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_002               I TPMAT_CHECK                   Check for Template Material                                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_INT_001           I DG_MAT_ASSIGN_FILTER          BAdI for Filtering the Specifications for Filling           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_INT_002           I MODIFY_DGDATA_AFTER_RECEIVING Check/Modify Dangerous Goods Data After Receiving           .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_INT_002           I MODIFY_DGDATA_BEFORE_SENDING  Check/Modify Dangerous Goods Data Before Sending            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_INT_002           I TRANSFER_EXTENSIONTAB_2_IOTAB Transfer Data from Extension Table to Internal Table        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_INT_002           I TRANSFER_IOTAB_2_EXTENSIONTAB Transfer Data from Internal Table to Extension Table        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MAINT_001         I BUTTON_DEF_GET                Set Icon Structure                                          .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MAINT_001         I DETAIL_ENTRY                  Call of Assigned Screen                                     .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MAINT_001         I DETAIL_SAVE                   Write Data to Buffer                                        .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MASTER_001        I DGMASTER_ENH_REC_DETERMINE    Det. Rel. Data Recs in DG Master Enh. f. Templ/One-Time Mat..
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MASTER_001        I DGTMD_RECORD_DETERMINE        Determination of a Dangerous Goods Master Record            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_MASTER_001        I DG_MASTER_SELECT              Selection of Dangerous Goods Master Records                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_OUTPUT_001        I DGMASTER_ENH_REC_DETERMINE    Determination of Relev. Data Records for DG Master Enhancemt.
IF_EX_EHS_DG_REL_001           I CREATE_FROM_CLASSIFICATION    Call of Intermediate Screen to Create Product Releases      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_REL_001           I ENTRY_PARAMETERS_CHECK        Incoming Check of Selection Parameters                      .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_REL_001           I SUBSCREEN_OK_CODE             OK Code Processing for Product Release Functions            .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_REL_001           I SUBSCREEN_OPEN                Preprocessing for Product Release Functions                 .
IF_EX_EHS_DG_REL_001           I TABSTRIP_INIT                 Transfer of Heading and Icon for Second Tab Page            .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP10_PREVIEW             Preview Handling                                            .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP10_PRINT               Print Handling                                              .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP11_CLOSE               Close Handling for Subscreen Printer                        .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP11_OKCODE              OK-Code Handling for Subscreen Printer                      .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP11_OPEN                Open Handling for Subscreen Printer                         .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP12_CLOSE               Close Handling for Subscreen Label Info                     .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP12_OKCODE              OK-Code Handling for Subscreen Label Info                   .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP12_OPEN                Open Handling for Subscreen Label Info                      .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_001         I CBGL_MP12_RESET               Reset Handling for Subscreen Label Info                     .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_002         I CBGL_LB70_DATA_GET            Extension for Reading Logistics Data (Make-to-Stock/Order)  .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_003         I CBGL_LB71_DATA_GET            Extension for Reading Logistics Data (Delivery)             .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_004         I CBGL_LB73_DATA_GET            Extension for Reading Logistics Data (Goods Receipt)        .
IF_EX_EHS_GLM_BADI_005         I CBGL_LB26_MATNR_TO_SUBID      Extension for Material-Substance Assignment                 .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization for Access to Material/Product Master   .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I CONVERT_MATERIAL              Conversion of Material/Product (Internal "--" External)     .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I EXISTENCE_CHECK               Run Existence Check for a Material/Product                  .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I F1_HELP_SHOW                  Display F1 Help for Attributes of Material/Product Master   .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I GET_DDIC_FIELD                Determine DDIC Field Name for Material Number               .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I GET_FIELD_LENGTH              Determine Field Length of Material Number                   .
IF_EX_EHS_MATERIAL             I GET_FIELD_NAME                Determine Language-Dependent Field Labels                   .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_CHANGE                  (See C10G_AENNR_CHANGE in PLM Add-On)                       .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_CHANGE2                 (See C11G_AENNR_CHANGE in PLM Add-On)                       .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_CHECK                   (See C10G_AENNR_CHECK in PLM Add-On)                        .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_CHECK2                  (See C11G_AENNR_CHECK in PLM Add-On)                        .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_SHOW                    (See C10G_AENNR_SHOW in PLM Add-On)                         .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_SHOW2                   (See C11G_AENNR_SHOW in PLM Add-On)                         .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_USE                     (See C10G_AENNR_USE in PLM Add-On)                          .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I AENNR_USE2                    (See C11G_AENNR_USE in PLM Add-On)                          .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I RC1A2NNR_LIST_TO_MEMORY       List for Report RC1A2NNR (in PLM Add-On) to Memory          .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I RC1AENNR_LIST_TO_MEMORY       List for Report RC1AENNR (in PLM Add-On) to Memory          .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I REPID_GET                     Report for Change Number Where-Used List 'Substance'        .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_001               I REPID_GET2                    Report for Change Number Where-Used List 'Phrase'           .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_002               I ENTRY_INQUIERY                (See C1G1_ENTRY_INQUIERY_APPOBJ in PLM Add-On)              .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_003               I AUSP_ADD_READ                 (See C14K_AUSP_ADD_READ in PLM Add-On)                      .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_003               I AUSP_ADD_UPD                  (See C14K_AUSP_ADD_UPD in PLM Add-On)                       .
IF_EX_EHS_PS_003               I CHARACTNAME_CHECK             (See C14K_CHARACTNAME_CHECK in PLM Add-On)                  .
IF_EX_EIDE_CRM                 I IDE_PROCESS_NECESSARY         IDE - Workflow Start - Check                                .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_COUNT_EINE             Returns number of entries in table eine                     .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_ENTRIES_IN_2  Used for select with all entries sentence number 2          .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_ENTRIES_IN_3  Used for select with all entries sentence number 3          .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_ENTRIES_IN_3_WSelect special fields with all entries                      .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_ENTRIES_IN_4  Used for select with all entries sentence number 4          .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_ENT_EKORG_IN_2Used for select with all entries sentence number 2 and ekorg.
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_FIELDS_FOR    Used for standard select and specified keys                 .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_ALL_FIELDS_IN     Used for standard select with in range sentence             .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_INFNR_ENTRIES_1   Used for select with all entries sentence #1 using infnr    .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_INFNR_ENTRIES_IN_RUsed for select with all entries and in range with INFNR    .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_INFNR_ENTRIES_SPECSelect  all entries with three parameters and werks with or .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_SPECIAL_FIELDS_FORUsed for select with special fields and specified keys      .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_SPECIAL_FIELDS_IN Used for select with special fields with ranges             .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I SELECT_EINE_WERKS_ENTRIES_1   Used for select with all entries with WERKS                 .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_EINE_FROM              Updates eine from an internal table                         .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_EINE_WHERE             Updates eine when a condition is met                        .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_VEINEUA_FROM           Updates eine from an internal table                         .
IF_EX_EINE_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_VEINEUB_FROM           Updates eine from an internal table                         .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I CHECK_BEFORE_CHANGE           Check before Changing Case                                  .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I CHECK_BEFORE_DISPLAY          Check before Displaying Case                                .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check before Saving Change to Case                          .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I COMPLETE_CASE                 Complete Case                                               .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I DETERMINE_CASE                Determine Case                                              .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I DETERMINE_CUSTOMER_SUBSCREEN  Determine Customer Subscreen                                .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I PROCESS_CUSTSUB_OKCODE        Handle Action (OKCode) from Customer Subscreen              .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_CUSTSUB    Transfer Case Data from Customer Subscreen                  .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_CUSTSUB      Transfer Case Data to Customer Subscreen                    .
IF_EX_EMMA_CASE                I UPDATE_CASE_ACTION_LOG        Write Action Log for Case                                   .
IF_EX_EQL_SUBSCR_ACL           I PROCESS_FUNCTION              Process by customer activated function in the log notif.    .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_01              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_02              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_03              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_04              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_05              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_06              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I FCODE_HANDLER                 Function Code Processing for the Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I GET_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Application                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I GET_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport BAdI Interface -" Screen                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I INIT_SCREEN                   Determine Important Screen Data (Example: Tab Name)         .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Data Transport Screen -" BAdI Interface                     .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data Transport Application -" BAdI Interface                .
IF_EX_EQUI_SCR_CC              I UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DATA          Update of Data Outside of the Equipment Tables              .
IF_EX_EQUI_SERLV_CHECK         I MAINTAIN_SERLV                Changeability of MARA_SERLV                                 .
IF_EX_EQUI_UPDATE              I IN_UPDATE                     Equipment Data to BADI 'IN UPDATE TASK'                     .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_CONFIG_MODE               Processing Mode for IPC Call                                .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_CONTEXT                   IPC Context Information for Reference Characteristic        .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_KB                        Determine Knowledge Base                                    .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_KB_DATE                   Set Date for Finding Knowledge Base                         .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_SALES_PRINT_OPTIONS       Determine Sales Print Options                               .
IF_EX_ERP_CFG_ADAPT            I SET_SALES_REF_CHARS_WRITABLE  Decide about support of writable reference characteristics  .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I AUTHORITY_CHECK_AFTER         Authorization Checks after the selections                   .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I AUTHORITY_CHECK_BEFORE        Authorization Checks before the Selection                   .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I PERFORM_SELECTION             Execute the Selection                                       .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I POSTPROCESS_RESULT            Post processing after the selections                        .
IF_EX_ERP_ISA_GEN_DOC_SEL      I PREPARE_SELECTION             Preparation before the Selection                            .
IF_EX_ESALES_PRODLIST_MOD      I MODIFY_PROPOSAL_FIELDCAT      Modify field catalog of proposal list                       .
IF_EX_ESALES_PRODLIST_MOD      I MODIFY_PROPOSAL_LAYOUT        Modify layout of product proposal list                      .
IF_EX_ESALES_PRODLIST_MOD      I MODIFY_SELECTION_FIELDCAT     Modify field catalog of list of selected products           .
IF_EX_ESALES_PRODLIST_MOD      I MODIFY_SELECTION_LAYOUT       Modify layout of list of selected products                  .
IF_EX_ESALES_PROD_DOCU         I MODIFY_PRODUCT_DOCU           Modify the standard product docu - sales text of material   .
IF_EX_ESALES_PROD_PROPOSAL     I MODIFY_PROPOSAL               Changes the automatic product proposal                      .
IF_EX_EVAL_SCHEDCOND_PPF       I EVALUATE_SCHEDULE_CONDITION   Evaluates the Schedule Condition                            .
IF_EX_EVAL_STARTCOND_PPF       I EVALUATE_START_CONDITION      Evaluates Start Condition                                   .
IF_EX_EWB_SELECTION            I BOM_PRE_SELECT                Preselection of BOM Headers                                 .
IF_EX_EWB_SELECTION            I ITM_PRE_SELECT                Preselection of BOM Items                                   .
IF_EX_EWB_SELECTION            I OPR_PRE_SELECT                Preselection of Operations                                  .
IF_EX_EWB_SELECTION            I TSK_PRE_SELECT                Preselection of Task List Headers                           .
IF_EX_EXEC_METHODCALL_PPF      I EXECUTE                       Execution of Processing Logic                               .
IF_EX_EXIT_RPCALCP0_002        I EXIT_PVACV                    VA - user exit 002                                          .
IF_EX_EXIT_RPCALCP0_PVACA      I EXIT_PVACA                    VA - user exit 003                                          .
IF_EX_EXIT_RPCALCP0_PVACO      I EXIT_PVACO                    VA user exit 005                                            .
IF_EX_EXIT_RPCTAXP0_01         I APPEND_INT_TABLES             Change internal tax tables                                  .
IF_EX_EXIT_SAPLCUKO_013        I CHECK_NO_BOM_EXPLOSION        Switch off BOM explosion when you go to configuration       .
IF_EX_EXIT_XFMPR1_001          I EXIT_FMPR_001                 BAdI Actual Update: PS Cash Management                      .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I GET_DEFAULT_SCENARIO          Derivation of Event Scenario                                .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I GET_NEW_EVENTS                Assignment of Events to Progress Tracking Object            .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I GET_REFERENCE_DATE            Determine Reference Dates of Events                         .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I PRINT_STATUS_NOTE             Print Status Information                                    .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I PROCEED_STATISTICS            Determine Key Figures Relevant to Statistics                .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I PROCESS_PUSH_BUTTON           Process Pushbutton                                          .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I READ_STATUS_NOTE              Read Status_Note                                            .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I SAVE_EVENTS                   Update Event Data on Saving                                 .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I SET_OBJ_TYPE                  Set Progress Tracking Object                                .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_FIELDCAT_MAINITEM      Edit Events Field Catalog                                   .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_FIELDCAT_SUBITEM       Edit Subitems Field Catalog                                 .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_INITIATOR              Set Field Initiator for po_meta                             .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_OBJ_FIELD              Supplement Fields for Tracking Objects                      .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_OFFSET                 Set Time Intervals During Scheduling                        .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_PUSH_BUTTON            Add/Hide Pushbutton for Toolbar                             .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_STATUS_NOTE            Update Status_Note Table Before Save                        .
IF_EX_EXPD_UPDATE              I UPDATE_SUB_ITEMS              Update Subitems When Progress Tracking is Called            .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_SWITCH         I ACTIVATION_CHANGE             Change Activation                                           .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_SWITCH         I AFTER_IMPORT_TBE11            Activation Change by Transporting a TBE11 Entry             .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_SWITCH         I SAVED_ON_DATABASE             Change to Activation Saved on the Database                  .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I ME_CALCUL_SRV_TAX             Tax Calculation for Services/Limit in Case of Item Changes  .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I ME_TAXCOM_MEPO                Modification of TAXCOM with Data from EKKO, EKPO, KNT       .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I MM_DATA_FOR_TAX_SYSTEM        Preparation and Sending of Additional Data for Tax System   .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I MM_ITEM_TAX_MODIFY            Change of Tax-Relevant Data for Invoice Item                .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I MS_TAX_DATA_LIMITS            Modification of Data for Tax Calculation for Limit          .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I MS_TAX_DATA_SERVICES          Modification of Data for Tax Calculation for Services       .
IF_EX_EXTENSION_US_TAXES       I MS_TRIGGER_PRICING            Pricing for Services When Service is Changed                .
IF_EX_EXTRACT_DATA             I CHECK_TABLE_ACCESS            checks whether the table access is allowed or not           .
IF_EX_EXTRACT_DATA_IPC         I CHECK_TABLE_ACCESS            checks whether the table access is allowed or not           .
IF_EX_EXT_CO_ACTUAL_DATA       I IMPORT                        Importing external data for actual CO postings              .
IF_EX_EXT_VALUATION_IAA        I GET                           External Valuation Determined for Activity Allocation       .
IF_EX_F050S008                 I ALE_COMPARE_LEDGER_UPDATE     Inbound IDoc: Update Remote Comparison Ledger               .
IF_EX_F181_DET_DEFAULT         I MOVE_ASSIGNMENT               Account Assignment Transfer                                 .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I CHANGE_CALCORDER              Change Sequence of Calculation in General                   .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I CHANGE_DEPRKEY_JAPAN          Change Temporary Dep. Key for Compl.Retirement (JAPAN Only) .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I CHANGE_PROPORTIONAL_VALUES_ERPChange Proportional Values Retirement/Retirement Transfer   .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I CHANGE_ROUNDING               Change Rounding Specifications                              .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I DEFINE_CHANGEOVER_YR          Specify Changeover Year Based on Values at Fiscal Year Start.
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I DEFINE_CHANGEOVER_YR_AND_PRD  Specify Changeover Year and Changeover Period               .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I DEFINE_SEGMENT_LENGTH         Specify Maximum Number of Periods Segment Can Have          .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I DEFINE_USE_OF_MAX_PERIODS     Specify If Calculation Is Made for Each Individual Period   .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_COUNTRY           I SET_PARAMETER                 Set Differing Calculation Parameters                        .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I CHANGE_CALCORDER              Change Sequence of Calculation in General                   .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I CHANGE_PROPORTIONAL_VALUES_ERPNot to Be Used, Since Not Called                            .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I CHANGE_ROUNDING               Change Rounding Specifications                              .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I DEFINE_CHANGEOVER_YR          Specify Changeover Year Based on Values at Fiscal Year Start.
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I DEFINE_CHANGEOVER_YR_AND_PRD  Specify Changeover Year and Changeover Period               .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I DEFINE_SEGMENT_LENGTH         Specify Maximum Number of Periods Segment Can Have          .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I DEFINE_USE_OF_MAX_PERIODS     Specify If Calculation Is Made for Each Individual Period   .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_CUSTOMER          I SET_PARAMETER                 Set Differing Calculation Parameters                        .
IF_EX_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS          I CHANGE_PARAMETER              Makes Possible to Change Transferred Calculation Parameter  .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_COUNTRY           I SET_BASE_VALUE                Determination of Base Value                                 .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_COUNTRY           I SET_MINVAL_VIRTAREA           Determination of Cutoff Value for Derived Areas             .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_COUNTRY           I SET_PERCENT_AMOUNT            Determination of Percentage Rate                            .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_CUSTOMER          I SET_BASE_VALUE                Determination of Base Value                                 .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_CUSTOMER          I SET_MINVAL_VIRTAREA           Determination of Cutoff Value for Derived Areas             .
IF_EX_FAA_EE_CUSTOMER          I SET_PERCENT_AMOUNT            Determination of Percentage Rate                            .
IF_EX_FAGLSKF_AUTH_EXIT        I CHECK_AUTH                    Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_FAGL_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I CHECK_LEDGER_AUTHORITY        Accounting Document: Authorization for Ledger               .
IF_EX_FAGL_AUTH_ADD_DATA_C     I CHECK_AUTH_GLU1               Authorization Check on GLU1 Data                            .
IF_EX_FAGL_AUTH_ADD_DATA_C     I CHECK_AUTH_ITEM               Authorization Check on Line Items                           .
IF_EX_FAGL_AUTH_ADD_DATA_S     I CHECK_AUTH_GLU1               Authorization Check on GLU1 Data                            .
IF_EX_FAGL_AUTH_ADD_DATA_S     I CHECK_AUTH_ITEM               Authorization Check on Line Items                           .
IF_EX_FAGL_COFI_ACCIT_MOD      I MODIFY_ACC_LINE_ITEM          Change FI/CO Line Item Before Summarization                 .
IF_EX_FAGL_COFI_ACDOC_MOD      I MODIFY_ACC_DOCUMENT           Change FI/CO Document Prior to Posting                      .
IF_EX_FAGL_COFI_LNITEM_SEL     I LINE_ITEM_SELECT              Select Individual Line Items for Online Update CO-"FI       .
IF_EX_FAGL_FICO_SELOPT_CNV     I FI_SELOPT_CONVERT_TO_CO       Convert Field Names and Values of FI to CO                  .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_CH_DATA       I CHANGE_ITEMS                  Change Line Data                                            .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_CH_SELD       I CHANGE_ITEMS                  Change Selected Data                                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE01       I LIST_ITEMS01                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE01       I LIST_ITEMS02                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE01       I LIST_ITEMS03                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE01       I LIST_ITEMS04                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE01       I SHOW_BUTTONS                  Display of Possible Actions on the Item List                .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE02       I LIST_ITEMS05                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE02       I LIST_ITEMS06                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE02       I LIST_ITEMS07                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE02       I LIST_ITEMS08                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_ITEMS_MENUE02       I SHOW_BUTTONS                  Display of Possible Actions on the Item List                .
IF_EX_FAGL_MIGR_SUBST          I SUBST_ITEM                    Set Account Assignments                                     .
IF_EX_FAGL_MIGR_VALIDATE       I VALIDATE_ITEM                 Validation of the Open Item                                 .
IF_EX_FAGL_MIG_ADJ_ACCIT       I ADJUST_ACCIT                  Adjustments to ACCIT                                        .
IF_EX_FAGL_SET_SEGMENT         I CHANGE_SEGMENT_PSEGMENT       Set Segment and Partner Segment                             .
IF_EX_FAGL_SPLVAL_ADJUST       I VALIDATION_ADJUST             Adjustment of Validation                                    .
IF_EX_FAGL_SPLVAL_ASSGNMT      I COMPLETE_ASSGNMT              Setting of Account Assignments                              .
IF_EX_FAGL_UPLOAD_CF           I MOVE_FIELDS                   Fill Receiver Structure from Sender Structure               .
IF_EX_FBAS_CIN_LTAX1F02        I FBAS_CIN_TAX                  India version tax interface                                 .
IF_EX_FBAS_CIN_MF05AFA0        I EWT_COPY_BSEG                 Copy Buzei of BSEG into WITH_ITEM                           .
IF_EX_FBAS_CIN_MF05AFA0        I EWT_DP_TAX_TRANSFER           Invoice - Down payment clear - Tax Transfer                 .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_001              I ADD_FIELDS_TO_BE_SELECTED     Add Fields to Be Selected from Database Tables              .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_001              I ADD_INFORMATION_TO_DATA_RECORDAdd Information to Selected Data Record                     .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_001              I MAP_COMPANY_IDS               Provide Mapping for Company IDs                             .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_001              I SUPPLY_OTHER_DATA             Supply Data Using Non Standard Logic                        .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_002              I ADD_INFORMATION_TO_DATA_RECORDAdd Information to Selected Data Record                     .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_002              I MAP_COMPANY_IDS               Provide Mapping for Company IDs                             .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_002              I SUPPLY_OTHER_DATA             Supply Data Using Non Standard Logic                        .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_003              I ADD_FIELDS_TO_BE_SELECTED     Add Fields to Be Selected from Database Tables              .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_003              I ADD_INFORMATION_TO_DATA_RECORDAdd Information to Selected Data Record                     .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_003              I MAP_COMPANY_IDS               Provide Mapping for Company IDs                             .
IF_EX_FB_ICRC_003              I SUPPLY_OTHER_DATA             Supply Data Using Non Standard Logic                        .
IF_EX_FB_RC_ASSIGNMENT         I PROCESS_AFTER_ASSIGN_ALL      Process After All Automatic Rules Have Been Run             .
IF_EX_FB_RC_ASSIGNMENT         I PROCESS_AFTER_ASSIGN_SINGLE   Process After One Automatic Rule Has Been Run               .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I ADD_CUSTOMER_UI_FUNCTIONS     Add Functions to Main Toolbar                               .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I CHANGE_MESSAGE                Change Message Text (e.g. Replace Placeholders)             .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I CHECK_ASSIGN_OK               Check Whether Assignment Is OK                              .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I CHECK_UNASSIGN_OK             Check Whether Assignment May Be Deleted                     .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I DISABLE_STANDARD_UI_FUNCTIONS Disable Standard Functions of User Interface                .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I MAP_COMPANY_IDS               Do not use!                                                 .
IF_EX_FB_RC_PRESENTATION       I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_UI_FUNCTIONS Processing for Added Functions                              .
IF_EX_FCOM_EQM_CHANGE          I CHANGE_CONTENT                Change Contents                                             .
IF_EX_FCOM_EQM_CHANGE          I CHANGE_LAYOUT                 Change Layout                                               .
IF_EX_FCOM_EQM_COSTS           I DETERMINE                     Determination of Costs                                      .
IF_EX_FCOM_EQM_EQUI_USER       I GET_EQUI_4_USER               Determine Equipment for User                                .
IF_EX_FCOM_EQM_EQUI_USER       I GET_USER_4_EQUIS              Determine User for Equipment                                .
IF_EX_FCOM_EXT_LEDGER          I CHECK_RELEVANT_FOR_CO         Check: Ledgers Relevant for CO?                             .
IF_EX_FCOM_FICO_SELOPT_CNV     I FI_SELOPT_CONVERT_TO_CO       Convert Field Names and Values of FI to CO                  .
IF_EX_FCOM_PLR_PEOPLE          I CHANGE_PEOPLE_RENDERER        Change to URL for People Renderer                           .
IF_EX_FCOM_PLR_ROOMPARAMS      I CHANGE_APPL_PARAMS            Change Application Parameters                               .
IF_EX_FCOM_PLR_ROOMPARAMS      I CHANGE_OWNER                  Change of Person Responsible                                .
IF_EX_FCOM_PLR_ROOMPARAMS      I CHANGE_PARAMS                 Change of Room Parameters                                   .
IF_EX_FCOM_PLR_ROOMPARAMS      I CHANGE_ROLENAMES              Change to Role Names                                        .
IF_EX_FCOM_VORGN_4_EXT_LDR     I SET_BUSINESS_TRANSACTIONS     Determine Transactions for Postings from Parallel Ledgers   .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I CANCEL_ENRICH_DOCUMENT_VAL    Cancel Valuation for Modified Documents                     .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I CHECK_KSTL_EXCESSR            Checks Responsible Cost Center and Additional Expense Reason.
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I CHECK_KSTL_REWORKR            Checks Responsible Cost Center and Reason for Rework        .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_ACT_LIST_EXCESS        Adds Items to Activity Posting for Excess Consumption       .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_ACT_LIST_REWORK        Adds Items to Activity Posting                              .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_COMP_LIST_EXCESS       Adds Items to Component Posting for Excess Consumption      .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_COMP_LIST_REWORK       Adds Items to Component Posting                             .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_DOCUMENT_REPORTING     Fill Enhancement of Reporting Structure                     .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I ENRICH_DOCUMENT_VALUATION     Modify Document Valuation                                   .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I GET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Default Values for Additional Expense                       .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I GET_EXCESS_COST_OBJECT        Determines Account Assignment Object for Additional Expense .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I GET_REWORK_COST_OBJECT        Determines Account Assignment Object for Rework Expense     .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I REM_GR_BAPI_DATA              Goods Receipt Repetitive Manufacturing                      .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SALARY_EXIT_CANCEL            Enhancement for Wage Interface with Reversal                .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SALARY_EXIT_EXCESS            Enhancement for Wage Interface with Additional Expense      .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SALARY_EXIT_EXCESS_POST       Enhancement for Wage Interface w/ Additional Expense (Post) .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SALARY_EXIT_REWORK            Enhancement for Wage Interface with Rework                  .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SALARY_EXIT_REWORK_POST       Enhancement for Wage Interface with Rework (Post)           .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SFC_GR_BAPI_DATA              Goods Receipt for Production Order                          .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SUBSYSTEM_EXIT                Exit for Subsystem with Inward Transfer                     .
IF_EX_FCO_COCKPIT_FUNCT        I SUBSYSTEM_EXIT_CANCEL         Exit for Subsystem with Inward Transfer (Storno)            .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_CEZP_REWORK            Adjusts the Rework Quantity in CEZP                         .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_CPZP_CHANGE_PARAMETERS Adjusts the Rework Qty in CPZP When Changing UoM            .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_CPZP_DELETE_REPPOINT   Adjusts the Rework Qty in CPZP When Deleting Reporting Point.
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_CPZP_REWORK            Adjusts the Rework Qty in CPZP                              .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_CPZP_REWORK_CANCEL     Adjusts the Rework Qty in CPZP During Cancelation           .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_ITAB_CPZP_REWQTY       Adjusts CPZP-REWQTY on Auto GR (Inward Transfer FCOST)      .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I ADJUST_KPZP1_FOR_SCRAP        Adjusts the Scrap Qty in KPZP1 for RM_OPERATION_READ_MULTI  .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I CORRECTED_PZPS_GET            Delivers Corrected RP Qties Incl. Predecessors to Rework    .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I FCO_ACTIVATED                 Delivers Customizing for Failure Cost Processing            .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_CANCEL_CHECK              Checks Whether Cancelation is Permitted in Repetitive Manuf..
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_CANCEL_FCO                Cancels FCO Document for Repetitive Manufacturing           .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_CANCEL_GR_CHECK           Checks if Cancelation of GR is Allowed in Repetitive Manuf. .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_DO_GOODS_RECEIPT_GET      Indicates that GR is Triggered from Cockpit                 .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_DO_GOODS_RECEIPT_SET      Determines that GR is Triggered from Cockpit                .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_GET_DATA_SUBSCREEN        Delivers Subscreen Data to Backflush                        .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_INITIALIZE_SUBSCREEN      Initializes Subscreen Data                                  .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_SET_CANCEL_BY_FCO         Sets Internal Flag - REM Cancelation BAPI Called From FCO   .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REM_SET_DATA_SUBSCREEN        Delivers Backflush Data to Subscreen                        .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REWORK_DOCUMENT_CREATE        Writes Failure Cost Document for Excluded Rework (REM)      .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I REWORK_QUANTITY_GET           Delivers Complete WIP and Rework Quantities                 .
IF_EX_FCO_CO_FUNCTIONS         I SCRAP_DOCUMENT_CREATE         Writes Failure Cost Document for Scrap (REM)                .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I CHECK_REWORK_DATA             Checks the Entered Rework Data                              .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I CHECK_SCRAP_DATA              Checks the Entered Scrap Data                               .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I GET_DATA_RM                   Makes Subscreen Data From Backflush Available               .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I GET_SUBSCREEN_REM_SCRAP       Delivers Subscreen for Failure Costs in Assembly Scrap      .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I GET_SUBSCREEN_REM_YIELD       Delivers Subscreen for Failure Costs in Outward Transfer    .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I INITIALIZE_DATA               Initializes the Failure Costs Data                          .
IF_EX_FCO_CUSTOMER_SPECIF      I SET_DATA_RM                   Makes Backflush Data Available for the Subscreen            .
IF_EX_FC_REALTIME_UPDATE       I SHIFT_UPDATE_PERIOD           Shift Period for Realtime-Update Data                       .
IF_EX_FC_ROLLUP                I CHANGE_PERIV_CONS             Override Fiscal Year Variant of Consolidation               .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_CASE_TITL     I GET_DEFAULT_CASE_TITLE        Determine Default Value for Title                           .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_CASE_TYPE     I GET_DEFAULT_CASE_TYPE         Determine Default Value for Case Type                       .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_CATEGORY      I GET_DEFAULT_CATEGORY          Determine Default Value for Category                        .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_DUE_DATE      I GET_DEFAULT_FIN_DUE_DATE      Determine Default Value for Processing Deadline             .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_EXT_REF       I GET_DEFAULT_EXT_REF           Determine Default Value for External Reference              .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_FIN_COORD     I GET_DEFAULT_FIN_COORDINATOR   Determine Default Value for Coordinator                     .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_NOTE          I GET_DEFAULT_NOTE              Determines Default Note                                     .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_PLAN_END      I GET_DEFAULT_PLAN_END          Determine Default Value for Planned Closing Date            .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_PRIORITY      I GET_DEFAULT_PRIORITY          Determine Default Value for Priority                        .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_PROCESSOR     I GET_DEFAULT_PROCESSOR         FSCM-DM: Determine Default Value for Processor              .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_REASON        I GET_DEFAULT_REASON_CODE       Determine Default Value for Reason                          .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DEF_RESPONSIB     I GET_DEFAULT_RESPONSIBLE       Determine Default Value for Person Responsible              .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DISP_COMPLETE     I COMPLETE_DISPUTE              Completion of Dispute Case                                  .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_DISP_WRITEOFF     I GET_POSTING_DATA              Structure of G/L Account Item for Writing Off Dispute Cases .
IF_EX_FDM_AR_UI_FIELDSTAT      I MODIFY_FIELDSTATUS            Modify Standard Field Status                                .
IF_EX_FDM_BEFORE_SAVE          I PUBLISH                       Notification of Local Dispute Cases before Save             .
IF_EX_FDM_COLL_SEND_ITEMS      I COMPLETE_DATA                 Determine Additional Data                                   .
IF_EX_FDM_P2P_JUDGE            I GET_P2P_STATE                 Valuate Promise to Pay                                      .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I MAP_CONTACTPARTNER_2_CONTACT  Translation of Business Partner to Contact Person           .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I MAP_CONTACT_2_CONTACTPARTNER  Translation of Contact Person to Business Partner           .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I MAP_CUSTOMER_2_PARTNER        Translation of Customer to Business Partner                 .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I MAP_CUSTOMER_2_PARTNERID      Translation of Customer to Business Partner (ID)            .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I MAP_PARTNER_2_CUSTOMER        Translation of Business Partner to Customer                 .
IF_EX_FDM_PARTNER_MAPPING      I SET_WORK_POOL                 Provide Worklist                                            .
IF_EX_FDM_USER_SCREEN          I CREATE_SCREEN_PAI             FSCM-DM: PAI Event of the User Screen for Creation          .
IF_EX_FDM_USER_SCREEN          I CREATE_SCREEN_PBO             FSCM-DM: PBO Event of the User Screen for Creation          .
IF_EX_FDM_USER_SCREEN          I DETAIL_NEEDED                 FSCM-DM: Call up detail screen for this case?               .
IF_EX_FDM_USER_SCREEN          I GET_CREATE_SCREEN             FSCM-DM: Define User Screen during Creation                 .
IF_EX_FEB_BADI                 I CHANGE_POSTING_DATA           Change Posting Data                                         .
IF_EX_FERC                     I FERC001                       Determine regulatory indicator or specify as clearing object.
IF_EX_FERC                     I FERC002                       Specific standard cost assignments of a cost center         .
IF_EX_FERC                     I FERC003                       Treatment of negative flows for a specific CO object        .
IF_EX_FERC                     I FERC004                       Additional checks before posting to G/L accounts            .
IF_EX_FERC                     I FERC005                       Assign missing regulatory indicator to final object         .
IF_EX_FIAA_BW_DELTA_UPDATE     I UPDATE_DEPRECIATIONS          Delta Tables of Depreciation Update Task                    .
IF_EX_FIAA_BW_DELTA_UPDATE     I UPDATE_MASTERDATA             Delta Tables of Master Data Update Task                     .
IF_EX_FIAA_BW_DELTA_UPDATE     I UPDATE_POSTING                Delta Tables of Posting Update Task                         .
IF_EX_FIAA_REVALUATE_ASSET     I CALCULATE_ASSET               Calculate Amounts for an Asset                              .
IF_EX_FICO_DEFINE_APPL         I GET_APPL                      Query Application                                           .
IF_EX_FICO_DEFINE_DIFF         I DIFF_VALUES_GET               Transfer of Value list for a Differentiation Category       .
IF_EX_FICO_DEFINE_FORMULA      I GET_OPERANDS                  Transfer Allowed Operator to Formula                        .
IF_EX_FICO_GET_ARCHIVEFLUD     I GET_ARCHIVE_FLUD              Determination of Resubmission Date for Archiving            .
IF_EX_FICO_SUPPL_CHECK         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_FICO_SUPPL_CHECK         I CHECK_CONDITION               Condition Checks                                            .
IF_EX_FIEB_CHANGE_STATEMNT     I CHANGE_DATA                   Change Bank Data Memory                                     .
IF_EX_FIEB_RETURNS_ADDIN       I CHANGE_RETURN_CHARGES         Process Returns                                             .
IF_EX_FIEB_RET_CHANGE_DOC      I CHANGE_BDCDATA                Change BDCDATA for Call Transaction FB09 (Change Item)      .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I EXECUTE_USER_COMMAND          Change BDT Field Group Status                               .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I FILL_BILLPLAN                 Fill/Add to Table with Payment Schedule Items               .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I FILL_CONDS                    Fill/Add to Table with Conditions                           .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I FILL_HEADER                   Fill LAE_CRM_HEADER                                         .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I FILL_ITEMS                    Fill LAE_CRM_ITEMS                                          .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA           Gets Contents for Additional Display Fields                 .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I GET_COMPONENT                 Gets Component for Current Contract Type                    .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I GET_EVENT                     Gets Different Process                                      .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I GET_PUSH_BUTTON_TEXTS         Makes Texts Available for Additional Pushbuttons            .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I MODIFY_FIELDGROUPS            Change BDT Field Group Status                               .
IF_EX_FILACI_ADDIN_METHODS     I PUT_ADDITIONAL_DATA           Makes Contents of Additional Display Fields Available       .
IF_EX_FILACI_DATA_MAP          I FILL_BILLPLAN                 Fill/Add to Table with Payment Schedule Items               .
IF_EX_FILACI_DATA_MAP          I FILL_CONDS                    Fill/Add to Table with Conditions                           .
IF_EX_FILACI_DATA_MAP          I FILL_HEADER                   Fill LAE_CRM_HEADER                                         .
IF_EX_FILACI_DATA_MAP          I FILL_ITEMS                    Fill LAE_CRM_ITEMS                                          .
IF_EX_FILA_ADDIN_METHODS       I HIDE_ENTRY_FROM_ALVGRID       Delete Individual Entries of an ALV Grid Container          .
IF_EX_FILA_CONTROLLING         I APPEND_CHARACTERISTICS        Transfer Additional Fields to Account Assignment Manager    .
IF_EX_FILA_MAP_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNM I MAP_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENT        Mapping of Fields for Call of Account Assignment Manager    .
IF_EX_FILA_MIGRATION           I ITEM_CHECK                    Check Contract Items                                        .
IF_EX_FILA_PERIOD_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check If the Period of the Effective Date Is Closed         .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_CONTRACT_ADJ     I ADJUST_CONTRACT_DATA          Method for Adjusting Contract Data                          .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_FOR_FINANC_MULTI        Check All Selected Items                                    .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_FOR_FINANC_SINGLE       Check a Single Item                                         .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_ACC_RULE           Is contract asset-relevant?                                 .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_CONTRACT_END_DATE  Check Contract End Date w/Refinancing Key Date              .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_CONTRACT_START_DATECheck Lease Start Date w/Refinancing Key Date               .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_PRES_VAL           Check Present Value per Contract                            .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_RES_VAL            Check Residual Value per Contract                           .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I CHECK_MIN_PV_TR               Check Present Value per Tranche                             .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_INTEREST                  Determine Interest Rate for Refinancing and PV Calculation  .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_ITEM_PV                   Determine Present Value per Contract                        .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_ITEM_RV                   Determine Residual Value per Contract                       .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_OUTSTANDING_PAYMENTS      Determine Total Outstanding Payments per Contract           .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_RESIDUALTERM              Determine Remaining Term per Contract                       .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SELEC_BADI       I GET_SALES_PRICE               Determine Sales Price per Contract                          .
IF_EX_FILA_RE_SEND_STATUS      I SEND_STATUS                   Send Status to Contract Management System                   .
IF_EX_FINB_CURR_CVTR           I CONVERT                       Convert Amount                                              .
IF_EX_FINB_CURR_CVTR           I GET_CONVERSION_RULES          Returns Conversion Rules                                    .
IF_EX_FINB_CURR_CVTR           I GET_REQUIRED_CHARS            Returns Characteristic Name for CONVERT (I_CHARACTERISTICS) .
IF_EX_FINB_REPORTING           I SHOW_ACTIVITY_TYPE            Display Activity Type                                       .
IF_EX_FINB_REPORTING           I SHOW_COST_CENTER              Display Cost Center                                         .
IF_EX_FINB_REPORTING           I SHOW_FI_DOCUMENT              Display FI Document                                         .
IF_EX_FINB_REPORTING           I SHOW_MATERIAL_MASTER_DATA     Display Material Master Data                                .
IF_EX_FINB_REPORTING           I SHOW_ORDER_MASTER_DATA        Display Master Data for Orders/Purchasing Documents         .
IF_EX_FINB_TYPE_AUTHORITY      I CHECK_MULTIPLE                Execute Authorization Check for Multiple Objects            .
IF_EX_FIOTP_DOC_ADJUST         I ADJUST_DOCUMENT               Adjust FI Document                                          .
IF_EX_FISLIS_AUTHORITY         I AUTHORITY_CHECK_EXEC          Execute Authorization Check                                 .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I CASH_DISCOUNT_SPLIT           Split Cash Discount                                         .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I DOCUMENT_AMOUNT_SPLIT         Item Split                                                  .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I EXCHANGE_RATE_SPLIT           Split Exchange Rate Differences                             .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I INTEREST_SPLIT                Split Interest Calculation                                  .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I IS_ACTIVE                     BSEG Split Active                                           .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I MOVE_ACCOUNT_TO_ITEM          Fill Account Information in BSEG Item (Structure)           .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I MOVE_TO_ACCIT                 Fill Account Assignment in FAGL_S_MIG_ASGMT Line (Structure).
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I MOVE_TO_BATCH_INPUT           Fill Account Assignment in BSEG Item (Batch Input)          .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I MOVE_TO_ITEM                  Fill Account Assignment in BSEG Item (Structure)            .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I PENALTY_SPLIT                 Split Penalty Interest                                      .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I TAX_SPLIT                     Split Tax on Sales and Purchases                            .
IF_EX_FISPLIT                  I TOTAL_AMOUNT_SPLIT            Balance Split                                               .
IF_EX_FIS_INVOICEDETAIL        I GET_INVOICE_DETAIL            Determine Detail Data for the Bill                          .
IF_EX_FITP_CUST_QUEUEING       I GET_QUEUEING_OFFICE           Method for Getting Queueing Office                          .
IF_EX_FITP_CUST_REMARKS        I CREATE_RM                     Method for Procurement of Remark Content                    .
IF_EX_FITP_INT_PLAN_EXP2       I CHANGE_RECEIPT_DATA           Edit Receipt Data After Completion of Integration           .
IF_EX_FITP_PREFERENCE_DATA     I GET_PREFERENCES               Get Preferences                                             .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_BOOK_DATA_PROPOSAL  Modification of Booking Data for Res. System (Contact, CC)  .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_CATEGORY_RES_SYSTEM Specify Reservation System with Service Request by Category .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_GDS_SYNC            Modification of Travel Plan Context with GDS Synchronization.
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_PAF_DATA            Generation of Elements for an Airline-Specific Program      .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_PAF_PRICING         Price Determination Behavior with Airline Programs          .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_PAF_SYNC            Synchronization of Elements for an Airline Program          .
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I CUSTOMIZE_PNR                 Modification of PNR Segments/Elements Before End of Transact.
IF_EX_FITP_TRAVEL_PLANNING     I INIT_UI_OTHER_SERVICE         Initialization of UI View "Other Travel Services"           .
IF_EX_FITV_CCC_M_LINE          I CHANGE_CCC_M_LINE             Modify M Lines of CCC File                                  .
IF_EX_FITV_PERSNO_AUTH_CHK     I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorizations                                        .
IF_EX_FITV_REP_CCC             I USE_ACCOUNTING_CURRENCY       Use Settlement Currency Instead of Receipt Currency         .
IF_EX_FITV_REP_TRAVEL_EXP      I CHANGE_SUMMARY_LINE           Edit Totals Lines                                           .
IF_EX_FITV_REP_TRAVEL_EXP      I GET_RATE_PER_MILE             Amount per Unit of Distance                                 .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_CHECK         I ARCHIVING_CHECK               Vendor Master Data Archiving: Additional Check of Gen. Part .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_CHECK_FI      I FI_ARCHIVING_CHECK            Vendor Master Data Archiving: Additional Checks in FI       .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_CHECK_MM      I MM_ARCHIVING_CHECK            Vendor Master Data Archiving: Additional Checks in MM       .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE         I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE         I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE         I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_FI      I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_FI      I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_FI      I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_MM      I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_MM      I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCPAYB_WRITE_MM      I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_CHECK         I ARCHIVING_CHECK               Customer Master Data Archiving: Add. Check of General Part  .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_CHECK_FI      I FI_ARCHIVING_CHECK            Customer Master Data Archiving: Additional Checks in FI     .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_CHECK_SD      I SD_ARCHIVING_CHECK            Customer Master Data Archiving: Additional Checks in SD     .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE         I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE         I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE         I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_FI      I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_FI      I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_FI      I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_SD      I DELETE                        Delete Additional Data from Database                        .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_SD      I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_ACCRECV_WRITE_SD      I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_BILA_OUTPUT           I ADDITIONAL_ACTIONS            Perform additional steps using GRID output table            .
IF_EX_FI_BSTM_MC_EXIT          I LIST_DOUBLE_CLICK             List Double-Click                                           .
IF_EX_FI_BSTM_MC_EXIT          I MODIFY_MAPPING                Change MultiCash Mapping                                    .
IF_EX_FI_BSTM_MC_EXIT          I PROCESS_MC_FILES              Process MultiCash Files                                     .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_CHECK         I CHECK_FOR_ARCHIVING           FI Document Archiving: Additional Check                     .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_IDX_DEL       I DELETE_FLAG_SET               Deletion of FI Secondary Index                              .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_WRITE         I DELETE                        Obsolete                                                    .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_WRITE         I PREPARE_DELETE                Read Additional Data from Archive and Delete from Database  .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_WRITE         I RELOAD                        Reload Additional Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_FI_DOCUMNT_WRITE         I WRITE                         Write Additional Data to Archive                            .
IF_EX_FI_DOC_DISP_LI           I DISPLAY_LINE_ITEM             Diversion to Document Items (FB03)                          .
IF_EX_FI_DUZI_ROUND_CML        I ROUND_AMOUNT                  Rounding as per Contract                                    .
IF_EX_FI_FB08_SUBST_BUDAT      I CHECK_BUDAT                   Check and Replace Posting Date                              .
IF_EX_FI_HEADER_SUB_1300       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_PAI      Data Import PAI                                             .
IF_EX_FI_HEADER_SUB_1300       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_PBO      Data Import PBO                                             .
IF_EX_FI_HEADER_SUB_1300       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_PAI        Data Export PAI                                             .
IF_EX_FI_HEADER_SUB_1300       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_PBO        Data Export PBO                                             .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I ASSIGN                        Event: Save Document Group Permanently (ICRCZ)              .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I ASSIGN_UNDO                   Event: Release Document Group                               .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I ITEM_UPDATE                   Data Procurement Event: Update Items                        .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I NEW_ITEM_ADD                  Data Procurement Event: New Item                            .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I PROCESS_STATUS_CHANGE         Event: Change to Processing Status                          .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I SAVE                          Event: Select Related Items (in ICRCA)                      .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20                I SAVE_UNDO                     Event: Deselect (in ICRCA)                                  .
IF_EX_FI_ICRC20_CNUM           I COMPANY_NUMBER_DETERMINE      Determine Company ID in Other System                        .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I GET_INT_SIGN                  Debit or Credit Interest Rate?                              .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_ADD_ITEMS                 Add/Remove Items                                            .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_CHANGE_ITEMS              Change Items before Interest Calculation                    .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_FORMULA                   Non-Linear Interest Formulas                                .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_GROUP                     Change to Grouping of Interest Items                        .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_LIST_01                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 1                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_LIST_02                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 2                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_LIST_03                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 3                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_MODIFY_ITEMS              Change Items after Interest Calculation                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_POST                      Change to Posting                                           .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_PRINT_OPTIONS             Change to Print Options                                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_PRINT_RESULTS             Processing of Smart Form Output Information                 .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_REVERSE                   Reversal of Interest Documents Posted                       .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_SEL_MOD                   Modification of Selection Criteria of Logical Database      .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_SHOW_BUTTONS              FCODES to be Hidden                                         .
IF_EX_FI_INT_CUS01             I INT_WRITE_ITEMS               Change Database Entries before Saving                       .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I GET_INT_SIGN                  Debit or Credit Interest Rate?                              .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_ADD_ITEMS                 Add/Remove Items                                            .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_CHANGE_ITEMS              Change Items before Interest Calculation                    .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_FORMULA                   Non-Linear Formulas                                         .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_GROUP                     Change to Grouping of Interest Items                        .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_LIST_01                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 1                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_LIST_02                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 2                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_LIST_03                   Branch from Interest Calculation List 3                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_MODIFY_ITEMS              Change Items after Interest Calculation                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_POST                      Change to Posting                                           .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_PRINT_OPTIONS             Change to Print Options                                     .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_PRINT_RESULTS             Processing of Smart Form Output Information                 .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_REVERSE                   Reversal of Interest Documents Posted                       .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_SEL_MOD                   Modification of Selection Criteria of Logical Database      .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_SHOW_BUTTONS              FCODES to be Hidden                                         .
IF_EX_FI_INT_SAP01             I INT_WRITE_ITEMS               Change Database Entries before Saving                       .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE01         I LIST_ITEMS01                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE01         I LIST_ITEMS02                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE01         I LIST_ITEMS03                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE01         I LIST_ITEMS04                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE01         I SHOW_BUTTONS                  Display of Possible Actions on the Item List                .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE02         I LIST_ITEMS05                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE02         I LIST_ITEMS06                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE02         I LIST_ITEMS07                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE02         I LIST_ITEMS08                  Follow-Up Actions from the Item List                        .
IF_EX_FI_ITEMS_MENUE02         I SHOW_BUTTONS                  Display of Possible Actions on the Item List                .
IF_EX_FI_LIMIT_ACCOUNT         I CHECK                         Check Master Data                                           .
IF_EX_FI_LIMIT_CURCONV         I CHECK                         Check Before Saving in View V_T001A                         .
IF_EX_FI_LIMIT_NEGPOST         I CHECK                         Check Before Saving in Views V_001_NP und V_001_B           .
IF_EX_FI_LIMIT_PROCESS         I CHECK                         Check Process to Determine Executability                    .
IF_EX_FI_PAYREF_BADI_010       I CREATE_KIDNO                  Determine Payment Reference Number                          .
IF_EX_FI_RCL_CLEARING_ACC      I EXCHANGE_CLEARING_ACC         Exchange Clearing Account                                   .
IF_EX_FI_RES_ITEM_CURRENCY     I CALL_FI_REPOST_OP             Call of Function Module FI_REPOST_OP                        .
IF_EX_FI_SL_BADI_DOCSELECT     I PROCESS_RWIN_DOC_SELECTION    Ledger Selection in Accounting Document                     .
IF_EX_FI_SL_BADI_POPER         I DERIVE_POPER_AND_FISCAL_YEAR  Derivation of Posting Period and Fiscal Year                .
IF_EX_FI_SL_BADI_RGUREC10      I PROCESS_SUBSTITUTION          Substitutions in Accounting Document in Foll.Posting Process.
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_010          I END_OF_LIST                   End-of-List Event in List Display                           .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_010          I END_OF_PAGE                   End-of-Page Event in List Display                           .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_010          I TOP_OF_PAGE                   Top-of-Page Event in List Display                           .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_011          I APPEND_TAX_ITEM               Event 'APPEND' for Line Item Lists                          .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_011          I SET_FLAGS                     Activate Call from 'APPEND_TAX_ITEM' (and more)             .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_012          I GET_BKPF_LATE                 Event 'GET bkpf LATE' during Selection                      .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_012          I SET_FLAG_USE_BADI_12          Activate Call for Method GET_BKPF_LATE                      .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_013          I SET_DMEE_PARAMETER            Set Parameters for DME Engine (Tree Type UMS1)              .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_014          I MODIFY_FIELDCAT               Modification of Field Catalog of Output List for ALV        .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_015          I END_OF_SELECTION              Event 'END_OF_SELECTION' before Creation of Data File       .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_015          I SET_FLAG_USE_BADI_15          Activate Call for Method GET_BKPF_LATE                      .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_016          I END_OF_SELECTION              Event 'END_OF_SELECTION' before Creation of Data File       .
IF_EX_FI_TAX_BADI_016          I SET_FLAG_USE_BADI_16          Activate Call for Method GET_BKPF_LATE                      .
IF_EX_FI_TRANS_DATE_DERIVE     I DERIVE_WWERT                  Derive Value Date                                           .
IF_EX_FKKCORR_EXP_9992         I CREATE_CORR_REQUEST           Create Correspondence Request                               .
IF_EX_FKKCORR_EXP_9992         I PRINT_CORR_REQUEST            Print Correspondence Request                                .
IF_EX_FKKFM_UPD_I              I FKKFM_UPD_BADI_1              Manipulate Tax Items                                        .
IF_EX_FKKINV_BAPIBILL          I COLL_BILL_PARTNER             Determine Business Partner of Collective Bill Account       .
IF_EX_FKKINV_BAPIBILL          I CONTRACT_ACCOUNT_DETERMINE    Determine Contract Account                                  .
IF_EX_FKKINV_BAPIBILL          I FILL_TRIG_CUSTOMER_FIELDS     Fill Customer Fields in Invoicing Order                     .
IF_EX_FKK_ID_PRENOTE           I CHECK_FORCING                 Check whether prenote may be updated                        .
IF_EX_FKK_ID_PRENOTE           I CHECK_PRENOTE                 Pre-selection of prenotes for updating of the prenote status.
IF_EX_FKK_PBS_CPR_NR           I MARK_CPR_TO_DELET             CPR number to be deleted                                    .
IF_EX_FKK_TAX_REP_00           I END_OF_PAGE                   Report Footer                                               .
IF_EX_FKK_TAX_REP_00           I END_OF_REPORT                 End of Report                                               .
IF_EX_FKK_TAX_REP_00           I MODIFY_DATA_B4_PRINT          Modify Data/Field Catalog Before Calling ALV                .
IF_EX_FKK_TAX_REP_00           I MODIFY_FIELDCAT_TOP           Modify Field Catalog at the Beginning                       .
IF_EX_FKK_TAX_REP_00           I TOP_OF_PAGE                   Report Header                                               .
IF_EX_FKK_WTAX_REP00           I ACTIVATE_FICA_FUNC            Activate FI-CA Functionality                                .
IF_EX_FKK_WTAX_REP00           I ADDTN_FICA_SELSCREEN          Additional Parameters on Selection Screen for FI-CA         .
IF_EX_FKK_WTAX_REP00           I MODIFY_FICA_PARTNER           Modify Individual Partner Data                              .
IF_EX_FKK_WTAX_REP00           I MODIFY_FICA_QSTRMAIN          Modify WT Items Before Processing Data                      .
IF_EX_FKK_WTAX_REP00           I MODIFY_FICA_WT_DATA           Modify WT Reporting Data Before Output                      .
IF_EX_FLEET_DECOUPLING         I CHECK_CONSUMP_MOVE            Indicator Check for Material Consumption                    .
IF_EX_FLEET_DECOUPLING         I CHECK_CONSUMP_TOL             Indicator Check for Consumption Tolerance                   .
IF_EX_FLEET_DECOUPLING         I HELP_CONSUMP_MOVE             F4 Help for Material Consumption Indicator                  .
IF_EX_FLEET_DECOUPLING         I HELP_CONSUMP_TOL              F4 Help for Consumption Tolerance Indicator                 .
IF_EX_FLL_SUBSCR_ACL           I PROCESS_FUNCTION              Process by customer activated function in the log notif.    .
IF_EX_FMALE_FUND               I INBOUND                       Inbound Exit                                                .
IF_EX_FMALE_FUND               I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Exit                                               .
IF_EX_FMAVC_ADD_LINES          I ADD_BUDGET_LINES              Add Additional Budget Records                               .
IF_EX_FMAVC_ADD_LINES          I ADD_POSTING_LINES             Add Additional Actual/Commitment Records                    .
IF_EX_FMAVC_BCS_ACTIVE         I CHECK_BCS_ACTIVE              Checks Whether BCS Budgeting is Active                      .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I CHECK_FUNDS_FM                Collect Data for AVK, FI-FM                                 .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I CHECK_FUNDS_LAST_DELETE       Checking Data of AVC (delete from parked documents=         .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I CHECK_FUNDS_LAST_FI           Check Data of AVC, FI                                       .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I CHECK_FUNDS_LAST_FM           Check Data of AVC, FI-FM                                    .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I CHECK_FUNDS_LAST_REVERSE      Check Data of AVC (Cancel)                                  .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I POST_FUNDS_FI                 Post Data of AVC, FI                                        .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DECO               I POST_FUNDS_FM                 Post Data of AVC, FI-FM                                     .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DERI_AFMA          I CHECK_ACO_ADDRESS             Perform checks for the availability control object          .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DERI_AFMA          I FILL_ADDRESS_SUPPL            Change field values of FMAVC_S_AFMA_ADDRESS_SUPPL           .
IF_EX_FMAVC_DERI_AFMT          I FILL_ACO_ADDRESS_SUPPL        Change field values of FMAVC_S_AFMT_ACO_ADDRESS_SUPPL       .
IF_EX_FMAVC_ENTRY_FILTER       I BUDGET_FILTER                 Apply filter exit for budget values                         .
IF_EX_FMAVC_ENTRY_FILTER       I POSTING_FILTER                Apply filter exit for posting values (from FM update)       .
IF_EX_FMAVC_EVENT              I MODIFY_AVC_MESSAGE            Redefine AVC message                                        .
IF_EX_FMAVC_EVENT              I MODIFY_MAIL_RECIPIENTS        Define E-Mail Recipients                                    .
IF_EX_FMBCS_RW                 I FILL_DATA                     Modify data in table record for reporting                   .
IF_EX_FMBCS_RW                 I GET_TEXT                      Get Texts for FMRBCS field descriptions                     .
IF_EX_FMBS_CHECK_STRUCTURE     I CHECK_BUDGET_STRUCTURE        Check Account Assignments in Budget Structure               .
IF_EX_FMBS_RIB_INTERFACE       I CHECK                         Data Check (Last Check)                                     .
IF_EX_FMBS_RIB_INTERFACE       I COLLECT                       Transfer Cmmt/Actual Data to RIB Ledger                     .
IF_EX_FMBS_RIB_INTERFACE       I POST                          Data Update                                                 .
IF_EX_FMBS_VALID_ADDRESS       I FILL_ADDRESS_SUPPL            Change field values of FMBS_S_BSAC_ADDRESS_SUPPL            .
IF_EX_FMBS_VALID_ADDRESS       I VALIDATE_BO                   Validate the FM Account Assignment for Budgeting            .
IF_EX_FMBS_VALID_ADDRESS       I VALIDATE_PO                   Validate the FM Account Assignment for Posting              .
IF_EX_FMBS_VALID_BO            I VALIDATE_BO                   Validate the address of budget object                       .
IF_EX_FMBW_CUSTOMER            I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data from the screen                              .
IF_EX_FMBW_CUSTOMER            I PRINT                         Print data                                                  .
IF_EX_FMBW_CUSTOMER            I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data to the screen                                .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Local Memory                                     .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I MAP_ADDITEM                   Copy Fields of Additional Item to Internal Display          .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I MAP_HEADER                    Copy Fields of Document Header to Internal Display          .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I MAP_ITEM                      Copy Fields of Document Item to Internal Display            .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I MAP_TAXITEM                   Copy Fields of Tax Item to Internal Display                 .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I UPDATE                        Update                                                      .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BAPIBILL         I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Customer-Specific Update                            .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I CHECK_REVERSAL_ORDER          Customer-Defined Check of Reversal Sequence                 .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ADDITEM  Fill Customer-Defined Fields in Addtnl Items of Reversal Doc.
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_HEADER   Fill Customer-Defined Fields in Reversal Document Header    .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ITEM     Fill Customer-Defined Fields in Reversal Document Items     .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_TAXITEM  Fill Customer-Defined Fields in Reversal Document Tax Items .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I REVERSAL_ITEM_ANALYZE         Analyze Reversal Document Item                              .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I UPDATE                        Customer-Defined Update                                     .
IF_EX_FMCAINV_BILL_CANCEL      I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Customer-Specific Update                            .
IF_EX_FMCCF_REFINE             I CFRULE_OVERRULE               FM Commitment Carryforward: Override FYC Rule               .
IF_EX_FMCCF_REFINE             I FILTER_OPEN_ITEMS             FM Commitment Carryforward: Open Item Filter                .
IF_EX_FMCCF_REFINE             I USERDIM_CHANGE                FM Commitment Carryforward: Change Customer-Specific Field  .
IF_EX_FMCCF_SET_STATISTIC      I STATISTIC_FLAG_SET            FM Commitment CArryforward: Set Statistics Indicator        .
IF_EX_FMCH                     I FMCH_BADI_1                   Determination of Fiscal Year for Reassigned FI Documents    .
IF_EX_FMCH                     I FMCH_BADI_2                   Force Reassignment of FI Original Documents                 .
IF_EX_FMCU_OPENPER             I GET_OPEN_PERIODS              Get open periods                                            .
IF_EX_FMCU_RULE                I GET_RULES                     Get rules                                                   .
IF_EX_FMCY_COPI_CO             I SET_TBUDTYPE                  Set Target Budget Type                                      .
IF_EX_FMEF_FACTORY             I CREATE_FACTORY                Returns a Factory for Earmarked Fund Objects                .
IF_EX_FMFGSPLBALANCING_AC_CUST I ADJUST_CLEARINGS              Adjust Accounting lines                                     .
IF_EX_FMFGSPLBALANCING_AC_CUST I CLEAR_ASSGNMT                 Do not delete necessary postings                            .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_CFG_CB      I DET_AP_DIM                    Determine the dimension for Accountable Property settings   .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_DET         I MOD_ACCOUNTABLE               Modify the accountable property determination               .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_NEWLINE     I ADD_LINES                     Add new lines per PO Item                                   .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_NEWLINE     I PREPOST_CHECK                 Perform customer check before posting                       .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_VAL         I CHANGE_VALUES                 Change values                                               .
IF_EX_FMFG_AC_PROP_VAL         I MESSAGE_EXCEPTION             Handle messages                                             .
IF_EX_FMFG_AUTH_CHECK_BADI     I ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENTS           Check on Account Assignments                                .
IF_EX_FMFG_BLSTRING            I FILL_STRUCTURE_GET            Get control data to fill the string                         .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE4USEXT       I GENERATE_NON_FM_ITEMS         Generate new Lines out of other than funds managment data   .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE4USEXT       I GENERATE_PAYMENT_ITEMS        Generates new payment lines in FM                           .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Check whether the scenario is active for a certain line     .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I DERIVE_ACCOUNTS               Derive account and offset per line and ledger area          .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I FIELD_MOVEMENT                Decision whether fields are moved into the resulting FI doc .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I GENERATE_NON_FM_ITEMS         Generate new Lines out of other than funds managment data   .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I GENERATE_PAYMENT_ITEMS        Generates new payment lines in FM                           .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I GET_BLEDGER_AREAS             Activates offset entries for budget lines                   .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORE_USEXT       I POPULATE_LINES                Get all the line items before collection                    .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORRECT          I LOADED_ITEMS_CHECK            Modify list of FM items to be processed                     .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORRECT          I PREPARE_TO_COLLECT_NEW        Modify data prior to delta collection step for new BL items .
IF_EX_FMFG_BL_CORRECT          I PREPARE_TO_COLLECT_ORIG       Modify data prior to delta collection step for existing BL  .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Check whether the scenario is active for a certain line     .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I DERIVE_ACCOUNTS               Derive account and offset per line and ledger area          .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I FIELD_MOVEMENT                Decision whether fields are moved into the resulting FI doc .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I GET_BLEDGER_AREAS             Activates offset entries for budget lines                   .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I ON_EXIT                       Trigger actions after BL processing                         .
IF_EX_FMFG_BUDGETARYLEDGER     I POPULATE_LINES                Get all the line items before collection                    .
IF_EX_FMFG_CCRVNDORMIGRATE     I CREATE                        Create Vendor Master Data                                   .
IF_EX_FMFG_CCRVNDORMIGRATE     I UPDATE                        Update Vendor Master Data                                   .
IF_EX_FMFG_DP_CLEAR            I ACTIVATE_DP_CLEARING          Activate logic for downpayment clearing                     .
IF_EX_FMFG_FACTS2_CATB         I CHANGE_SYSTEM_DEFAULT         Change System Default for Apportionment Category B field    .
IF_EX_FMFG_FMABP_BED_HDR       I SET_HEADER_ATTRIBUTES         Set Budget Entry Document attributes                        .
IF_EX_FMFG_FUNDMSG_DRV_DEF     I FM_DERIVE_FND_MESSAGE         Derive fund message                                         .
IF_EX_FMFG_IMPROPER_PANEL      I UPDATE_PANEL                  Update User Defaults on Improper Invoice                    .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_GR_SPLIT         I SPLIT_GR                      Split GR/IR algorithm                                       .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_MULTIFUNDING     I FIELDS_DEFAULT                Default fields in PR Multi funding tab screen               .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_MULTIFUNDING     I FINANCE_AMOUNT                Default finance amount in the PO Multi funding tab screen   .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_PO_DEFAULT       I FINANCE_AMOUNT                Default finance amount                                      .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_PRHOLD_NOREL     I ACTIVATE_PRHOLD_NOREL         Activate logic to prevent release strategy for held PR      .
IF_EX_FMFG_MM_PR_DEFAULT       I PR_DEFAULT                    BADI Method for Multi Funding PR Screen                     .
IF_EX_FMFR_ALLOW_DOCCATS       I GET_ALLOWED_DOCCATS           Determination of Permitted Document Types                   .
IF_EX_FMFR_FORMDATA            I FORM_ADDATA                   Fill in Data Prior to Printing Form                         .
IF_EX_FMFR_JOURN               I FILTER_AND_COMPLETE           Filter/Complete Selected Data                               .
IF_EX_FMFUNDSRES               I SET_PFSTATUS_DETAIL           Change Dynpro Status on the Detail Screen                   .
IF_EX_FMFUNDSRES               I SET_PFSTATUS_LIST             Change Dynpro Status on the Overview Screen                 .
IF_EX_FMFUNDSRES               I SET_PFSTATUS_PMDOC            Change of Dynpro Status for Value Adjustment Documents      .
IF_EX_FMGL_MIGRATION_FAGL_FMGL I MOVE_FIELD_CONTENTS_ACTUALS   Copy Field Content Actual Data                              .
IF_EX_FMGL_MIGRATION_FAGL_FMGL I MOVE_FIELD_CONTENTS_PLAN      Copy Field Content Plan Data                                .
IF_EX_FMKU_BUDGET_EVNT         I DOCUMENT_CHECKS               Checks on the document                                      .
IF_EX_FMKU_BUDGET_EVNT         I LINE_CHECKS                   Checks the lines                                            .
IF_EX_FMKU_BUDGET_EVNT         I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_FMKU_BUDGET_LINES        I ADD_LINES                     Creates additionnal lines                                   .
IF_EX_FMKU_BUDGET_LINES        I SUBSTITUTE_DATA               Substitutes the values of fields on the lines               .
IF_EX_FMKU_GROUPING_KEY        I GET_FM_GROUPING_KEY           From FM data, gives back a identification key               .
IF_EX_FMPA_END_MONTH           I METHOD_END_MONTH_TO_UPDATE    Define Expiry Period                                        .
IF_EX_FMPD_CHECKLINE           I CHECK_LINE                    Check Entry Line                                            .
IF_EX_FMPU_R_USERDIM           I SET_USER_DIMENSION            Set Customer Field                                          .
IF_EX_FMRE_BUS_PROCESS         I BUS_PROC_EXTEND               Enhancement of permitted business processes (Transaction)   .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_1                   Value Type Determination for 30-30 Postings                 .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_2                   Ledger-Dependent Statistics Update                          .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_3                   Fill Field FMVOR                                            .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_4                   Determine Due Date                                          .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_5                   Account Assignment Derivaton After Reassignment             .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_6                   Update Date for Reduction Records of Parked Documents       .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_7                   Principle of prudence                                       .
IF_EX_FMRI                     I FMRI_BADI_90                  Activation of Summary Update                                .
IF_EX_FMRO_LINE_EDIT_INIT      I INITIALIZE_VALUES             Modify schedule contents on initial creation                .
IF_EX_FMRO_LINE_EDIT_INIT      I SET_EDITABILITY               Control types of editing user can perform                   .
IF_EX_FMRO_POSTING             I POSTING_HEADER                Modify the header interface values before posting           .
IF_EX_FMRO_POSTING             I POSTING_LINE                  Modify the detail interface values before posting           .
IF_EX_FMRP_ACCOUNT_AUTH        I CHECK_ACCOUNT_AUTHORITY       Check FI Account Authorization                              .
IF_EX_FMRP_RFFMEPGAX_EXIT      I CHANGE_LIST_LINE              Change or check line item fields before list is issued      .
IF_EX_FMRP_RFFMEPGAX_EXIT      I CHANGE_LIST_TABLE             Change or check table for line items                        .
IF_EX_FMR_CONSUMPTION_RW       I CHANGE_REFERENCE_ENTRY        Change Consumption Data of Earmarked Funds                  .
IF_EX_FMR_SCENCHECK            I CHECK_ALL_ITEMS               Check on Entries in Table                                   .
IF_EX_FMR_SCENCHECK            I CHECK_ITEM                    Check Customizing Entries                                   .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_CONTROLLER       I FILL_CUSTOM_COBL_FIELDS       Update user defined fields in COBL                          .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_CONTROLLER       I FILL_CUSTOM_DERIVE_FIELDS     Populate user defined fields from COBL data                 .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_DISTRIB_METH     I DISTRIBUTE                    Calculate the amount to allocate to a split                 .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_DISTRIB_METH     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization at beginning of processing a rule            .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I DELETE_RULE                   Chance to cancel rule deletion                              .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I MOVE_DATA                     Move/validate data during PAI processing                    .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I SPLIT_ALV_DATA_CHANGED        Handle data changed event for the ALV that displays splits  .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I SPLIT_FIELDCAT                Influence field catalog for the ALV that displays the splits.
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I SPLIT_MAINT_INITIALIZE        Provide parameters about how to maintain splits for a rule  .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I SPLIT_MAINT_PBO               PBO processing for custom subscreen                         .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I TRANSPORT_REQUEST             To include custom data when a rule is added to a transport  .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_MAINTENANCE      I VALUES_FIELDCAT               Influence field catalog for the ALV for the field values    .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I CHECK_CUSTOM_DATA_CHANGED     Indicate if custom data was modified                        .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I LOAD_RULE_FROM_DB             Move custom fields to editing structure during load from db .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I MOVE_RULE_TO_DB               Move basic rule data from editing structure to db table     .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I MOVE_SPLIT_TO_DB              Move custom split fields from editing structure to db table .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I RENUMBER_SPLIT_ID             Assign permanent ID for splits                              .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_DB          I SAVE_RULE                     Save custom data to database                                .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_PROCESS     I ALL_FIELD_VALUE_ASSIGNMENT    Method to completely take over account assignment values    .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_PROCESS     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization activities at start of rule processing       .
IF_EX_FMSPLIT_RULE_PROCESS     I ONE_FIELD_VALUE_ASSIGNMENT    Method to do a single account assignment field              .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I FILL_CVP_TXT_VAR              Fill Text Variables for Reciprocal Cover Eligibility        .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I FILL_CVU_TXT_VAR              Fill Text Variables for Unilateral Cover Eligibility        .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I FILL_GLOBAL_TXT_VAR           Fill General Text Variables                                 .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I FILL_RIB_TXT_VAR              Fill Text Variables for Revenues Increasing the Budget      .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I FILL_WRITE_INFO               Define Information for Writing FM Account Assignment        .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I GET_CVP_TXT_VAR               Text Variables Allowed for Reciprocal Cover Eligibility     .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I GET_CVU_TXT_VAR               Text Variables Allowed for Unilateral Cover Eligibility     .
IF_EX_FMTX_HVM                 I GET_RIB_TXT_VAR               Text Variables Allowed for Revenues Increasing the Budget   .
IF_EX_FM_AUTH_OLD_ACTIVITY     I OLD_ACTIVITY_CHECK_ACTIVE     Activate Check on Old Activities                            .
IF_EX_FM_BCF_US_SUBTP          I SET_SUBTYPE                   Sets or changes subtype depending on subtype or budget type .
IF_EX_FM_BGACODERIVE           I DERIVE_CO_ACCOUNT             Deriving CO Account Assignment                              .
IF_EX_FM_BL_NONRELEVANT        I DEFINE_IRRELEVANT_LINE        Define non relevant lines for budgetary ledger              .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPLICATION       I FILL                          Transfer Data and Check                                     .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPLICATION       I LAST_CHECK                    Last Check (e.g.Availability Control)                       .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPLICATION       I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPLICATION       I ROLLBACK                      Reset Buffer                                                .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPROVAL          I MARK_BUDGET_APPROVAL          Set CFLEV for Commitment Carryforward with Budget           .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_APPROVAL          I SET_APPROVAL_TEXTS            Pushbutton Text for Second Approval Step                    .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_SMOD_SAPLFMC1     I EXIT_SAPLFMC1_002             Check Carry Over Flag in Funds Reservations                 .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_SMOD_SAPLFMC1     I EXIT_SAPLFMC1_003             Read Exception Table: Crryfwrd Parameters for Each Doc. No. .
IF_EX_FM_CCF_SMOD_SAPLFMC1     I EXIT_SAPLFMC1_005             Individual Setting for Statistic Indicator                  .
IF_EX_FM_CCL_FILTER_ITEMS      I CHECK_CLOSEOUT_RULES          FM FYC - Rules on Filtering Open Items                      .
IF_EX_FM_CCOVR_CONTROL         I DEFINE_VALUE_TYPES            Exclude Value Types for Reassignment                        .
IF_EX_FM_CI_KEY_STRUC          I CHECK_KEY_STRUC               Check of Substructure                                       .
IF_EX_FM_CV_BADI_STRID         I CV_FILL_STRID                 Structure ID from FM Area and Fiscal Year                   .
IF_EX_FM_CV_BAPI_STRID         I CV_FILL_STRID                 Structure ID from FM Area and Fiscal Year                   .
IF_EX_FM_DATES_ENHANCEMENT     I APP_FUNDS_DATES_ACTIVE        Returns if validity dates for Appl. of Funds are active     .
IF_EX_FM_DATES_ENHANCEMENT     I FUNCT_AREA_DATES_ACTIVE       Returns if validity dates for Functional Area are active    .
IF_EX_FM_EF_FACTORY            I CREATE_FACTORY                Generating a Factory Object                                 .
IF_EX_FM_EF_GROUP              I CHECK_EF_GROUP                Check Group                                                 .
IF_EX_FM_EF_GROUP              I PROCESS_OUTPUT_FIELDS         Fields Not Ready For Imput                                  .
IF_EX_FM_EF_GROUP              I SELECT_ALL_MEMBERS_OF_GROUP   Select All Document Items of a Group                        .
IF_EX_FM_FC_KEY_STRUC          I FM_FC_KEY_STRUC_PBO           PBO Substructure                                            .
IF_EX_FM_FC_KEY_STRUC          I FM_FC_KEY_STRUC_POP_UP        Call Dialog Box Substructure                                .
IF_EX_FM_FC_KEY_STRUC          I GET_ACTIV_FLAG                Is Substructure Active                                      .
IF_EX_FM_FKK_CCF_TOT_COLL      I ADJUST_FOR_COLLECT            Influence Fields for Summarization for Summary Carryforward .
IF_EX_FM_FYC_DERIVE            I COPY                          Fill Additional Fields for Derivation                       .
IF_EX_FM_FYC_DERIVE            I DERIVE                        Derivation Step as Enhancement                              .
IF_EX_FM_FYC_DERIVE            I RETURN_MESSAGE                Additional Return Parameters                                .
IF_EX_FM_GLACC_DERIVE          I COPY                          Fill Additional Fields for Derivation                       .
IF_EX_FM_GLACC_DERIVE          I DERIVE                        Derivation Step as Enhancement                              .
IF_EX_FM_LIST_HEADER_ADDIN     I ADD_TEXT_AND_PICTURE          Output Additional Information or LOGO in List Output        .
IF_EX_FM_LIST_HEADER_ADDIN     I CHANGE_BACKGROUND             Change Background for List Header                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUBID_TYPE         I CHECK_SUBID_TYPE              Check the Subdivision ID                                    .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUBSTRINGS         I FIPOS_CHECK_SUBSTRINGS        Check parameters used for commitment item                   .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUBSTRINGS         I FISTL_CHECK_SUBSTRINGS        Check parameters used for funds center                      .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUBSTRINGS         I FUNCTION_CHECK_SUBSTRINGS     Check parameters used for functional area                   .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUBSTRINGS         I FUND_CHECK_SUBSTRINGS         Check parameters used for fund                              .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_CISUB1           Check commitment item substring 1                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_CISUB2           Check commitment item substring 2                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_CISUB3           Check commitment item substring 3                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_CISUB4           Check commitment item substring 4                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_CISUB5           Check commitment item substring 5                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FCSUB1           Check funds center substring 1                              .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FCSUB2           Check funds center substring 2                              .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FCSUB3           Check funds center substring 3                              .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FDSUB1           Check fund substring 1                                      .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FDSUB2           Check fund substring 2                                      .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FNSUB1           Check functional area substring 1                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FNSUB2           Check functional area substring 2                           .
IF_EX_FM_MD_SUB_VALUES         I CHECK_VALUES_FNSUB3           Check functional area substring 3                           .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I GET_FIELD_STATUS_NP           Get Field Status for NP Order assignment to FM objects      .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I GET_FIELD_STATUS_NV           Get Field Status for NV Order assignment to FM objects      .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I GET_FIELD_STATUS_PM           Get Field Status for PM Order assignment to FM objects      .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I GET_FIELD_STATUS_SD           Get Field Status for SD Order assignment to FM objects      .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I NP_DATA_COPY_TO_COBL          Copy NP Order Data to structure COBL                        .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I NV_DATA_COPY_TO_COBL          Copy NV Order Data to structure COBL                        .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I PM_DATA_COPY_TO_COBL          Copy PM Order Data to structure COBL                        .
IF_EX_FM_ONLINE_ASSIGNMENT     I SD_DATA_COPY_TO_COBL          Copy SD Order Data to structure COBL                        .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_ACTUALS                 FI Update/Funds Management FM_DOCUMENT_CLOSE                .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_CCF_DP_PREVIOUS         Closing Operations: Carry Frwd Down Payment check previous  .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_CCF_DP_RECEIVER         Closing Operations: Carry Frwd Dwn Payment check receiver   .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_CCF_DP_SENDER           Closing Operations: Carry Frwd Down Payment check sender    .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_CCF_RECEIVER            Fiscal Yerr Change: Commitment Carry Forward check receiver .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_CCF_SENDER              Fiscal Yerr Change: Commitment Carry Forward check sender   .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_FMCHA1                  Reassignment tool. FM_CHANGE_AA_DOCFM_READ                  .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_FMCHA_OI                Reassignment tool.  FM_CHANGE_AA_DOCFM_OI                   .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_FMCU                    FM-Controlling integration check                            .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_FMPAY                   Payment selection of original function check                .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_FMPU_R                  Zahlungsfortschreibung im HHM (online)                      .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_PARKING                 FI Update/Funds Management Parking or Reverse PP            .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_PAYMENTS                Payment Conversion in Funds Management check                .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I CHECK_REVERSAL                FI Update/Funds Management Reversals                        .
IF_EX_FM_OPEN_PERIODS          I OPEN_INTERVAL_CHECK           Allow alt. check and/or perform check for Comm Updating     .
IF_EX_FM_PBC_DIFF_BUDTRANS     I CHANGE_BUDGET_TRANSFER        Adjust Budget Transfer Posting                              .
IF_EX_FM_POP_CORE              I CHECK_DOCUMENT_IS_POP         Check if document is POP                                    .
IF_EX_FM_POP_CORE              I CHECK_POP_ACTIVE              Retrieve customized POP_FLAG                                .
IF_EX_FM_POP_DERIVE            I COPY_EXTRA_VALUES             Copy Additional values to PoP Derivation Tool               .
IF_EX_FM_POP_ENHANCE           I POP_EXTRA_CUSTOMIZING         Additional POP Customizing                                  .
IF_EX_FM_REQUESTS              I DOCS_CHECK                    Additional checks                                           .
IF_EX_FM_REQUESTS              I REACT_ON_OKCODE               OK Code Processing                                          .
IF_EX_FM_REQUESTS              I SET_PFSTATUS                  Change to Screen Status on Request Screen                   .
IF_EX_FM_REQUEST_GL_ACC        I DERIVE_GL_ACCOUNT             Account determination                                       .
IF_EX_FM_TABS_PRINT            I PRINT_ACTIVE                  Activation of BADI Printout                                 .
IF_EX_FM_TABS_PRINT            I PRINT_TABS                    Printout of Day-End Closing                                 .
IF_EX_FM_TOT_UPDATE            I FM_TOT_ACTIVE                 Summary Update is Used                                      .
IF_EX_FM_USRFLDS_SGLCD         I SET_USER_FIELDS_VALUES        Set values for addtl user fields for the SGL code derivation.
IF_EX_FOPC_CASE_MAND_FIELD     I CHECK_MANDATORY_FIELDS        Checks If Case Fields Are Required Entry Fields             .
IF_EX_FOPC_CI_CASE_FLDATTR     I GET_DROPDOWNLB_VALUES         Adopt Values in Dropdown List                               .
IF_EX_FOPC_CI_CASE_FLDATTR     I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTE           Load Field Properties into User Interface                   .
IF_EX_FOPC_CI_CASE_PRINT       I CI_CASE_PRINT                 Format Custom Fields in Print Report                        .
IF_EX_FOPC_REPORT_DATA         I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify Data After "LOAD_REPORT"                             .
IF_EX_FOPC_REPORT_DATA         I REMOVE_COLUMNS                Remove Columns from Dropdown List Boxes in Print Report     .
IF_EX_FOPC_REPORT_WEIGHT       I GET_WEIGHT                    Return Weight for Report Line                               .
IF_EX_FOPC_US_AUTH             I GET_PERSON_FROM_USER          Determine Person for User                                   .
IF_EX_FOPC_US_AUTH             I GET_USER_FROM_PERSON          Determine User to Person                                    .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_BC               I SEND_DECLARATION_BC           Transfer Advance Tax Return with Business Connector         .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_DECL             I COMBINE_DECLARATIONS          Combination of Returns for Joint Transfer                   .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_DECL             I CREATE_PROXY_DATA             Generation of Proxy Interface Parameters                    .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_DECL             I CREATE_XML                    Generate XML File                                           .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_DECL             I EDIT_AMOUNTS                  Country-Specific Preparation of Amounts                     .
IF_EX_FOT_VAT_XI               I SEND_DECLARATION_XI           Transfer Advance Return for Tax on Sales/Purchases with XI  .
IF_EX_FOX_DISPLAY              I CHANGE_LINE                   Alternative Line Format                                     .
IF_EX_FOX_DISPLAY              I CHANGE_TOP_LINE               Alternative Line Format (Top-Level Object)                  .
IF_EX_FOX_DISPLAY              I CHANGE_VALIDITIES             Alternative Validity Format                                 .
IF_EX_FOX_DISPLAY              I CHANGE_VALIDITY_FLAG          Instantiate Validities Independent of Format                .
IF_EX_FOX_DISPLAY              I OTHER_DISPLAY                 Alternative Format                                          .
IF_EX_FOX_OBJECT               I MODIFY_EXCLUDED_LINK_TYPES    Modification of Excluded Links                              .
IF_EX_FPB_AUTHORISATIONS       I CHANGE_RESPAREA               Change Area of Responsibility                               .
IF_EX_FPB_CMPERS_AUTHORITY     I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Object Authorization                                 .
IF_EX_FPB_LAUNCHPAD            I MODIFY_URL_PARAMETER          Change to the URL Parameter                                 .
IF_EX_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_BADI       I FILL_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION       Fills Field for Custom Enhancement                          .
IF_EX_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_BADI       I MODIFY_REPORT_LIST            Change Report List                                          .
IF_EX_FPB_PERS_CHECK_AUTH      I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_FPB_PERS_CHECK_EXIST     I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Existence Check                                             .
IF_EX_FPB_PERS_CONVERT         I CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT            Conversion from External to Internal Format                 .
IF_EX_FPB_PERS_CONVERT         I CONVERT_INT_TO_EXT            Conversion from Internal to External Format                 .
IF_EX_FPB_PERS_RESOLVE         I GET_RESOLVED_DATA             Breakdown of Intervals and Groups                           .
IF_EX_FPB_SNI_APPL             I CHANGE_SUBOBJECTS             Change to the Subnodes                                      .
IF_EX_FP_XFP_DEVICE            I GET_XFP_DEVICE                Determine XFP Output Device                                 .
IF_EX_FQST_CALC_COUNTRY        I CALC_BASE_PER_TYPE            Calculate WT Base Amount and Modify WITH_ITEM               .
IF_EX_FQST_CALC_COUNTRY        I DETERM_BASE_FOR_CHECK         Determine WT Base Amount for Minimum Check                  .
IF_EX_FQST_CALC_COUNTRY        I SET_ACCOUNTING_DOCUMENTS      Set Accounting Document Header and Item to MT_BKPF/MT_BSEG  .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_SURCHARGE       I CALC_INH_BASE_CEINV           Inherit Base Enabled for Central invoice prop.              .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_SURCHARGE       I CALC_INH_BASE_CEINV_PP        Inherit Base Enabled for Ceinv prop for partial payment.    .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_COPY_BUPLA                Copy Bupla into BSEG                                        .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_COPY_CLEAR_WITH_ITEM      Get Line item for Clearing EWT Lines                        .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_COPY_LIV_BSEG             Copy QSSKZ into BSEG for LIV docs.                          .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_COPY_LIV_WITH             Copy BSEG-BUZEI into WITH_ITEM table for LIV invoices       .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_COPY_WITH_ITEM            Copy BSEG-BUZEI into WITH_ITEM table                        .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_GET_BUPLA                 Get Bupla of Vendor Line                                    .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_REASSIGN                  Re assigning the lines in bseg                              .
IF_EX_FQST_CIN_WITHITEM        I EWT_SPLIT_INVOICE             Recognize split invoices                                    .
IF_EX_FREFINT_DEFINITION       I BEFORE_SCREEN_DELETE          Before Deletion of Data in Display                          .
IF_EX_FREFINT_VALUES           I AFTER_DB_SAVE                 After Saving the Data in the Database                       .
IF_EX_FREFINT_VALUES           I BEFORE_DB_SAVE                Before Saving the Data in the Database                      .
IF_EX_FRE_ARTHIER_MOD          I MODIFY_ARTHIER                Modify Article Hierarchy Data befor sending to F&R          .
IF_EX_FRE_MCH_ID_MOD_BADI      I CHANGE_ID                     Change MC-ID / MCH-Node-ID                                  .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_DIF_CHANGE        I CHANGE_DIF_MENGE_WEIGHT       Change value & weight profile of DIF occurence              .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_DIF_REF_PROMO     I DELETE_REF_PROMO              Delete promotions that are only used as reference           .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_DIF_SEND          I CHANGE_DIF_BEFORE_SEND        Change DIF occurences before sending and saving on DB       .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_DIF_WAKT          I ABI_SAVE_FROM_PROMOTION       Saves Data in ABI Administration after Promotion Changes    .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_DIF_WAKT          I WALE_DATA_DELIVER             Transfers WALE Data when Reading Promotion Data             .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_LOCGRP_SEND       I MODIFY_LOCGRP                 Change Reference Site data before sending to F&R            .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_LOC_SEND          I CHANGE_DATA_BEFORE_SEND       Change location data before sending to F&R                  .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_MATLOC_TRANSFER   I CHANGE_DATA_BEFORE_TRANSFER   Change Product Location-Porduct data before sending to F&R  .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_PROCYC_SEND       I CHANGE_DATA_BEFORE_SEND       Modification of procurement cycles before sending to F&R    .
IF_EX_FRE_MD_SUPP_NET_SEND     I CHANGE_DATA_BEFORE_TRANSFER   Modifikation Supply Network Objects before sending to F&R   .
IF_EX_FRE_ORD_INBOUND          I DOCUMENT_BEFORE_BAPI          Data before BAPI_STOREORDER_CREATE is called                .
IF_EX_FRE_ORD_IN_DOCTYPE       I ORDER_INBOUND_DOCTYPE         Document Type Determination                                 .
IF_EX_FRE_ORD_IN_PROMOTION     I ORDER_INBOUND_PROMOTION       Promotion Determination                                     .
IF_EX_FRE_ORD_RTFASHION        I ORDER_FASHION_FUNCTIONS       Fashion Functionality for Order Proposal Data               .
IF_EX_FRE_PLIFZ_ADAPT_TCID     I ADAPT_ROUTES                  Mark relevant transportation routes for transportation chain.
IF_EX_FRE_PLIFZ_DET_SITE       I DETERMINE_DELIVERING_SITE     Determine delivering site                                   .
IF_EX_FRE_PLIFZ_DET_SITE       I DET_MATNR_WERKS_FROM_WRF3     Insert relevant MARC from WRF3 (not highest priority)       .
IF_EX_FRE_PO_BEFORE_OUT        I PO_BEFORE_OUT                 Modify Purchase Order Data before Transmission to F&R       .
IF_EX_FRE_REF_MATLOC_SEND      I CHECK_REF                     Check reference fields in MATLOC-Data before sending        .
IF_EX_FRE_SET_LAYMOD           I SET_LAYMOD_DATA               change layout module data                                   .
IF_EX_FRE_STRUCT_ART_IN_PO_OUT I STRUCT_ART_CHECK              Manage Structured Article in Order Outbound                 .
IF_EX_FRE_T001W_ACCESS         I FRE_T001W_READ                Read table T001W                                            .
IF_EX_FRE_WLOSITEREF_ACCSS     I FRE_REF_TO_WERKS_READ         read reference site to site                                 .
IF_EX_FRE_WLOSITEREF_ACCSS     I FRE_REF_WERKS_CHECK           Check Reference                                             .
IF_EX_FRE_WRS1_ACCESS          I FRE_WRS1_SELECT_FOR_LAYGR     Read database table WRS1                                    .
IF_EX_FRML_CALC_DATA_CONV      I CALC_DATA_FORMAT_CONVERSION   Convert Formula Data to EH&S Data                           .
IF_EX_FRML_CMP_VALUES_CALC     I CHECK_CMP_VALUES              Convert Units                                               .
IF_EX_FRML_EXPLOSION_CHECK     I DEF_EXPL_FLAG_CHECK           Checks Whether the Standard Explosion Indicator is Set      .
IF_EX_FRML_FORMULA_DIALOG      I OUTPUT_SUBSTANCE_PROTECT      Ready for Input Status of Output Subst.(I/O Substances View).
IF_EX_FRML_NTR_CMP_CHECK       I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Additional Check for Nutrient Compositions                  .
IF_EX_FRML_PREF_RCP_CHECK      I PREF_RCP_CHECK                Filter Formulas in Explosion                                .
IF_EX_FRML_USAGE_GET           I USAGE_GET                     BADI: Usage Determination                                   .
IF_EX_FSBP_ADDFLD_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Additional Data Was Created or Changed                      .
IF_EX_FSBP_ADDINF_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Additional Information Was Created or Changed               .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_ADD_BAPI      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           TransferExtensionIn                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_ADD_BAPI      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           ValidateExtensionIn                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_CHG_BAPI      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           TransferExtensionIn                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_CHG_BAPI      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           ValidateExtensionIn                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_GET_BAPI      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          TransferExtensionOut                                        .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_GET_BAPI      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           ValidateExtensionIn                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_ALIAS_REM_BAPI      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          TransferExtensionOut                                        .
IF_EX_FSBP_ARCH_RFC_DATA       I RFC_DEST_GET                  Read RFC Destination                                        .
IF_EX_FSBP_BANK_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Bank Data Created or Changed                                .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP001_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process FS-Specific Attributes                              .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP011_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Create Employment Data                                      .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP021_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Create Fiscal Year Information                              .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP1012_SUPR_CHK     I SUPPRESS_CHECK                Returns Whether or Not Check Should Be Skipped              .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP1012_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Ratings                                             .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP1013_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Differentiated Attributes                           .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP1030_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Create Regulatory Reporting Data                            .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP3010_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Additional Data                                     .
IF_EX_FSBP_BP3100_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Additional Information                              .
IF_EX_FSBP_BPID_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Additional Partner Numbers                          .
IF_EX_FSBP_BUSYEAR             I FSBP_BP021_EXPORT             Export of Fiscal Year Data to the Mirror Tables             .
IF_EX_FSBP_BUSYEAR             I FSBP_BP021_IMPORT             Import of Fiscal Year Data from the Mirror Tables           .
IF_EX_FSBP_BUSYEAR_IMPORT      I FSBP_BP021_IMPORT             Import of Fiscal Year Data                                  .
IF_EX_FSBP_BUT021_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Time-Dependent Address Usages                       .
IF_EX_FSBP_BUT0BANK_UPDATE     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Process Bank Data                                           .
IF_EX_FSBP_DIFF_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Differentiated Attributes Were Created or Changed           .
IF_EX_FSBP_EMPLOY_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Employment Data Was Created or Changed                      .
IF_EX_FSBP_FIS_YEAR_UPDATE     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Fiscal Year Data Was Created or Changed                     .
IF_EX_FSBP_GDPDU_DATA_GET      I PARTNER_DATA_GET              Read Additional Business Partner Data                       .
IF_EX_FSBP_IDENT_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Additional Business Partner Numbers Were Created or Changed .
IF_EX_FSBP_RATING_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Ratings Were Created or Changed                             .
IF_EX_FSBP_REPORT_UPDATE       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Regulatory Reporting Data Was Created or Changed            .
IF_EX_FSBP_RE_EXIST            I CHECK_RE_ACTIVE               Check Whether Real Estate Application Is Active             .
IF_EX_FSBP_SELECT_EXTERNAL     I EXPORT_F4_SELECTION           Exports Partner Selection                                   .
IF_EX_FSBP_SELECT_EXTERNAL     I UPDATE_FIELD_VALUES           Completes Default Field Values                              .
IF_EX_FSBP_SELECT_EXTERNAL     I UPDATE_PARTNER_SETTINGS       Completes Basic Values for Partner                          .
IF_EX_FSBP_SGS_UPDATE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Characteristics for the Bank Analyzer Are Being Created     .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_AUTHORITY        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_CALC_SUM         I COMPUTE                       Determine Values for Totaling                               .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_DISPLAY          I CHANGE_TITLE                  Change Header for Total Commitment                          .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_DISPLAY          I HANDLE_EVENT_OF_LIST          Transfer Events in List Output                              .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_DISPLAY          I ITEMS_DISPLAY                 Display Total Commitment                                    .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_DISPLAY_CB       I HANDLE_EVENT_USER_COMMAND     Offer ALV Event USER_COMMAND for Processing                 .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_ITEMSGETMULT     I ITEMS_GET_MULTIPLE            Read Application Data                                       .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_MAP_BP_KEYS      I CONVERT_EXT_TO_TC             Transfer BP No. + BP GUID from External to Local System     .
IF_EX_FSBP_TC_MAP_BP_KEYS      I CONVERT_TC_TO_EXT             Transfer BP No. + BP GUID from Local to External System     .
IF_EX_FSBP_TRBP_IMPORT         I FSBP_BP001_IMPORT             Import of Treasury Attributes                               .
IF_EX_FSBP_TRBP_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Treasury Data Was Created or Changed                        .
IF_EX_FSBP_TREAS_ORG_DATA      I FSBP_BP001_EXPORT             Export of Organizational Data to the Mirror Tables          .
IF_EX_FSBP_TREAS_ORG_DATA      I FSBP_BP001_IMPORT             Import of Organizational Data from the Mirror Tables        .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I CALCULATE_FOR_CASHFLOW        Calculate key figures from a general cash flow              .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I CALCULATE_FOR_DPTRANSACTIONS  Calculate key figures from any datapool transactions        .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I CALCULATE_FOR_FXOPTION        Calculate key figures from an option                        .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I CALCULATE_FOR_SFGDT           Calculating the key figures for a risk object               .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I CALCULATE_FOR_VTB             Calculates the key figures for a TRM transaction            .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I DETAILED_LOG_GET              Copy Log to Local Structure                                 .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I DETAILED_LOG_INITIALIZE       Initialization of the Detail Log                            .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I DISPLAY_USED_MARKETDATA       Display Calculation Bases                                   .
IF_EX_FTBB_KEYF_ENGINE         I SET_IR_PARALLEL_SHIFT         Definition of a Parallel Shift (in Base Points)             .
IF_EX_FTBB_MD_VOLA_COMPUTE     I INTERPOLATE_VOLA              Interpolation of Volatility Variables (3-Dimensional)       .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_BAV                  I EVT_TRANSACTION_SET_DATA      Transfer Data for Enhancement in BAPI                       .
IF_EX_FTR_CORR_INC_100         I CHANGE_MAPPED_TRANSACTIONS    Reduce/Increase Assigned Transactions                       .
IF_EX_FTR_CORR_INC_100         I GET_BUSINESS_PARTNER_ID       Change/Adopt Business Partner ID                            .
IF_EX_FTR_CORR_INC_100         I GET_COMPANYCODE               Specify Company Code (Optional in Process)                  .
IF_EX_FTR_CORR_INC_100         I TRIGGER_FINAL_ACTION          Perform Activities when Processing has Finished             .
IF_EX_FTR_CORR_OUT_100         I CHANGE_IDOC                   Change IDoc Control Record                                  .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_CUSTOMER_EXTENT      I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_FINANCIAL_OBJECT     I EVT_TRANSACTION_SET_DATA      Transfer Data for Enhancement in BAPI                       .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I CONSISTENCY_CHECK_DEAL_DATA   Check Transaction Data (Authorized? Currencies OK?)         .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I CONSISTENCY_CHECK_MARKET_DATA Check Market Data (Current Rates/Swap Rates?)               .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I DEAL_VALIDITY_CHECK           Check Whether Transaction and Rate Still Accepted           .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I DEAL_VALIDITY_GET             Determine Offer Validity                                    .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I DEFAULT_VALUES_GET            Limit the Values and/or Preassigned Values                  .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I MARGIN_ADJUSTMENT_CROSS_RATE  Adjust the Margin for Cross-Rate Transactions               .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I MARGIN_ADJUSTMENT_SIMPLE_RATE Adjust the Margin for "Simple" Transactions                 .
IF_EX_FTR_FX_INT_EXIT          I RATE_TYPES_GET                Determine the Rate Types for Bid and Ask                    .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SET_DATA      Transfer Data for Enhancement in BAPI                       .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT_USER      I FILL_VTVBAR                   Determine NPV                                               .
IF_EX_FTR_HEDGE_MGMT_USER      I INITIALIZE_HEDGE_DATA         Enter Default Hedge Accounting Subscreen Data               .
IF_EX_FTR_MA_LAUNCH            I GET_LAUNCHER_CONTENT          Definition of the Applications for the MA Launcher          .
IF_EX_FTR_MA_LAUNCH_1STP       I CHANGE_START_PAGE             Start Page for the MiniApp Launcher to be Changed.          .
IF_EX_FTR_MA_LAUNCH_CUSTOM     I CHANGE_LAUNCHER_CONTENT       Definition of the Applications for the MA Launcher          .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_MIRROR_DEALS         I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_PARTNER_ASSIGN       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SET_DATA      Transfer Data for Enhancement in BAPI                       .
IF_EX_FTR_SE_DEFAULTS          I SET_CALENDAR                  Preset Calendar                                             .
IF_EX_FTR_SE_DEFAULTS          I SET_CALENDAR_REPO             Default Calendar for Repos                                  .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_DERIVATION       I GET_ADDITIONAL_DERIVATIONS    Returns Additional Derivations for Tax Generation           .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_CML      I CALCULATE_PRQ_AMOUNTS         Returns the Amounts for the Payment Request                 .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_CML      I CREATE_FI_TABLES_FOR_VAT      Makes the FI Tables Available for Calculatng Value-Added Tax.
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_CML      I CREATE_FI_TABLES_FOR_WT       Makes FI Tables Available for Calculating Withholding Tax   .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_CML      I GENERATE_TAX_FLOWS            Generates Tax Flows from Transferred Planned Records        .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_CML      I PREPARE_FI_TABLES_FOR_VAT     Enhances FI Tables with Flow Type (for Value-Added Tax)     .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_SE       I PREPARE_FI_TABLES             Fills FI Tables for Tax Calculation                         .
IF_EX_FTR_TAX_POSTING_TR       I GENERATE_TAX_FLOWS            Generates Tax Flows from Transferred Flows                  .
IF_EX_FTR_TRACA_STATREPORT     I FILL_APPEND_STRUCTURE         Determine and Fill Structure Differentiation Characteristics.
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_DEAL_FIX                  "Fixes" Transactions                                        .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_DEAL_UPD                  Changed Transactions                                        .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_DISTRIBUTOR       I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_EXTENTION         I HAS_EXTENTION                 Enhancement Available?                                      .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_FCODE         Execute Fcode in BAdI                                       .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FACILITY          I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_FIMA_CALLBACK     I AMOUNTCOMP_DETERMINE          Determination of Proportion of Interest to Be Capitalized   .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_APPLICATION_FREE          Release Resources                                           .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_APPLICATION_START         TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_TRANSACTION_CHECK         Explicit Transaction Check Required by User                 .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL   Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK    Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY    Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_GENERIC           I EVT_TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_LOAN_EB           I EVT_TR_LOAN_EB_DATA_1         Calculation of Interest on Arrears                          .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_LOAN_EB           I EVT_TR_LOAN_EB_DATA_2         Generation of Postings for Interest on Arrears              .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_LOAN_EB           I EVT_TR_LOAN_EB_REJECTION      Change Interpretation Result (If Posting to Rejection)      .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_LOAN_EB           I EVT_TR_LOAN_EB_SGTXT          Default Setting of Document Segment Text                    .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_LOAN_PP           I TR_LOAN_PP_01                 Posting Data Change                                         .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_TBB1_EXIT         I VBUND_EXIT                    Determining Partner Company ID (VBUND)                      .
IF_EX_FTR_TR_TIME              I GET_TIME                      Time and Date for Contract Conclusion and Dependent Fields  .
IF_EX_FVDE                     I OBJEKTE_BEVOR_DB_UPDATE       CCC Objects: After Conversion Before Database Update        .
IF_EX_FVDE                     I SICHERHEITEN_BEVOR_DB_UPDATE  CCC Collateral: After Conversion Before Database Update     .
IF_EX_FVD_ACCOUNTREF_PART      I GET_INDUSTRY_SECTOR           Get Standard Industry of Partner for Account Assignment Ref..
IF_EX_FVD_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I ACCOUNTING_DETERMINATION      User Exit For Account Determination                         .
IF_EX_FVD_ADDFLOW              I CHECK_ASSESSMENT              Check Prerequisite                                          .
IF_EX_FVD_ADDFLOW              I CHECK_AUTOWAIVE               Check Automatic Waiver                                      .
IF_EX_FVD_ADDFLOW              I GET_AMOUNT                    Calculate Amount                                            .
IF_EX_FVD_ADDFLOW              I GET_CALC_BASIS                Determine Calculation Base                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_ADDFLOW              I GET_FLOW_ATTRIBUTES           Get Parameters from Condition Table                         .
IF_EX_FVD_ALOI_CLERK           I DETERMINE_CLERK_TYPE          Determination of Activity Type or Role Category             .
IF_EX_FVD_AUTODRAFT            I CHANGE_RESULTS                Change Values in Results Table                              .
IF_EX_FVD_AUTODRAFT            I CREATE_DETAIL_RECORDS         Create Detail Records                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_AUTODRAFT            I CREATE_FOOTER                 Creae Footer Records                                        .
IF_EX_FVD_AUTODRAFT            I CREATE_HEADER                 Create Header Records                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_AUTOWAIVE            I CHECK_WAIVE_RULE              Check Waiver Rule                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_BILL_DATA_CHANGE     I MODIFY_BILL_INFORMATION       Change Billing Information                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_BILL_PRINT           I EXPORT_BILL                   Export of All Information for Printing of Bill              .
IF_EX_FVD_BILL_REM_DERIVE      I GET_REMITTANCE_DATA           Read Remittance Code                                        .
IF_EX_FVD_BUSOP_GEN_DYNPRO     I CALL_UI_MAINTAIN              Calls FVD_XXX_MAINTAUIN_UI of the Business Operation        .
IF_EX_FVD_BUSOP_GEN_DYNPRO     I CALL_UI_PROCESS_UCOMM         Call FVD_XXX_PROCESS_UCOMM_UI of the Business Operation     .
IF_EX_FVD_BUSOP_GEN_DYNPRO     I GET_GUI_OBJECTS               Supplies Program, Screen, GUI Status, FCTAB and GUI Title   .
IF_EX_FVD_CALL_RBD_INT         I CALL_RBD_ACCOUNT              Branch to RBD Account / Display                             .
IF_EX_FVD_CAPTR_OL             I EXIT_CAPTR_OL_001             Output Formatting of Customer Data                          .
IF_EX_FVD_CAPTR_UI             I EXIT_CAPTR_UI_001             Activate and Name Customer Tabs                             .
IF_EX_FVD_CAPTR_UI             I EXIT_CAPTR_UI_002             Transfer User Data to Subscreen (Customer Tab 1)            .
IF_EX_FVD_CAPTR_UI             I EXIT_CAPTR_UI_003             Transfer User Data From Subscreen (Customer Tab 1)          .
IF_EX_FVD_CLI_CONTRIBUTION     I CLI_CONTRIBUTION              Calculate Credit Life Insurance Single Premium              .
IF_EX_FVD_CLI_RECALC           I CLI_RECALCULATION             Calculate Reimbursement for Credit Life Insurance           .
IF_EX_FVD_COND_VERIFIER        I VERIFY                        Customer-Specific Checks                                    .
IF_EX_FVD_COND_VERIFIER        I VERIFY_CHANGE_KOPO            Customer-Specific Checks for Changing Condition Items       .
IF_EX_FVD_COND_VERIFIER        I VERIFY_DELETE_KOPO            Customer-Specific Checks for Deleting Condition Items       .
IF_EX_FVD_COND_VERIFIER        I VERIFY_INSERT_KOPO            Customer-Specific Checks For Inserting Condition Items      .
IF_EX_FVD_CONTRACT_CREATE      I HANDLE_LOAN_CONTRACT          Loans - Process All Customer Enhancements                   .
IF_EX_FVD_CORRESPONDENCE       I LOAD_INSURANCE_CHARGE         Load Single and Multiple Costs                              .
IF_EX_FVD_CORRESPONDENCE       I LOAD_INSURANCE_DATA           Load General Data for LI, Start, Duration, Tariff.....      .
IF_EX_FVD_CORRESPONDENCE       I LOAD_INSURANCE_DIFFERENCE     Load Benchmark Figures for Insurance                        .
IF_EX_FVD_CORRESPONDENCE       I LOAD_INSURANCE_REPAYMENT      Load Life Insurance Data in Repayment Schedule              .
IF_EX_FVD_CORRESPONDENCE       I LOAD_INSURANCE_SAMPLE         Load Model Calculation for Life Insurance                   .
IF_EX_FVD_CREDIT_BUREAU        I CHANGE_RESULTS                Change Values in Output Table                               .
IF_EX_FVD_DCALLEND_OL          I FVD_DCALLEND_OL_CHECK_ACTIVE  Check Whether Provision Expiry Date is Activated            .
IF_EX_FVD_DCALLEND_OL          I FVD_DCALLEND_OL_CHECK_AUSZ_DATCheck Date Fields Disbursment                               .
IF_EX_FVD_DCALLEND_OL          I FVD_DCALLEND_OL_CHECK_VERT_DATCheck Date Fields Contract                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_DCALLEND_OL          I FVD_DCALLEND_OL_PREP_DCALLEND Default Setting Provisions Expiry Date                      .
IF_EX_FVD_DEFCAP               I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEFCAP_OL_001    Plausibility Check for Deferral + Capitalizn of O-due Items .
IF_EX_FVD_DISB_CHECK_N_SET     I CALC_ADISBGROSS               Calculation of Gross Disb. Amount Different from Standard   .
IF_EX_FVD_DISB_CHECK_N_SET     I CHANGE                        Change Processing Different from Standard                   .
IF_EX_FVD_DISB_CHECK_N_SET     I CHECK_DISB                    CHECKS Different from Standard                              .
IF_EX_FVD_DISB_CHECK_N_SET     I SET_ADAPTION                  Automatic Changes Different from Standard                   .
IF_EX_FVD_DUNNING              I ACC_API_CHECK_SEL_OPT         Check Whether Items Relevant for Interest Calculation       .
IF_EX_FVD_DUNNING              I DULV_PR_SET                   Set Current Procedure for Assigning Dunning Levels          .
IF_EX_FVD_DUNNING              I DUNN_OPT_ARC_SET              Archiving Dunning Notices                                   .
IF_EX_FVD_DUNNING              I HISTORY_COMPLETE              Write Entries in Dunning History with Dunning Level 0       .
IF_EX_FVD_DUNNING              I IOA_CALCULATE                 Calculate Interest on Arrears                               .
IF_EX_FVD_EFFINT_CONDITION     I ADJUST_CONDITIONS             Adjust Conditions                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_EFFINT_DISBURSEM     I ADJUST_DISBURSEMENT_DATA      Adjust Start Date and Disbursement Date                     .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_CAPITALS_AFTER         Process Capital Amounts                                     .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_CASHFLOW_AFTER         Process Cash Flow                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_COLLATERAL_AFTER       Process Collateral                                          .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_CONTRACT_AFTER         Edit Master Data                                            .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_LOAN_GENERAL_AFTER     Process Entire Loan                                         .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_OBJECT_AFTER           Process Collateral Object                                   .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT               I HANDLE_VALUES_AFTER           Process Collateral Value                                    .
IF_EX_FVD_EXPORT_OFFERS        I GET_CONDITION_HEADER          Determine Condition Header for the Offer Valuation          .
IF_EX_FVD_FNM1_DATE            I SET_FNM1_DATE                 Setting of Posting Date and Payment Date                    .
IF_EX_FVD_HANDLE_FORMULA       I DELETE_FORMULA                Delete Assignment of Formula to Condition                   .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_MASTERDATA      I CHECK_CONTRACT_ON_SAVE        Contract Check Before Save                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_OPEN_ITEMS      I MODIFY_LIST                   Modify Selectionability of Items                            .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_ANBWA_IN_BSEG          Fill Attachements Flow Type                                 .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_BKTXT_IN_BKPF          Fill Document Header Text                                   .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_FIPOS_IN_ACCIT         Fill Commitment Item                                        .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_FISTL_IN_ACCIT         Fill Funds Center                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_FKBER_IN_ACCIT         Fill Function Area                                          .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_GEBER_IN_ACCIT         Fill Funds                                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_GSBER_IN_BSEG          Fill Business Area                                          .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_KBLNR_IN_ACCIT         Fill Document Number Earmarked Funds                        .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_KBLPOS_IN_ACCIT        Fill Document Item Earmarked Funds                          .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_LZBKZ_LANDL_IN_BSEG    Fill State Central Bank ID and Supplying Country            .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_MABER_IN_BSEG          Fill Dunning Area                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_PROJK_IN_BSEG          Fill PSP Element                                            .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_RMVCT_IN_BSEG          Fill Flow Type                                              .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_SGTXT_IN_BSEG          Fill Item Text                                              .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I CHANGE_VBUND_IN_BSEG          Enter Partner Company                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I GET_BLDAT                     Determine Document Date                                     .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_POST            I GET_BUDAT                     Determine Posting Date                                      .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_RETURN_DEB      I USER_PROCESS_RETURNED_DEBIT   Processing of Returned Debit Memos                          .
IF_EX_FVD_LOAN_REVERSE         I CHANGE_REVERSE_ITEM           Adjust Standard Proc.for Pmnt Block, Pmnt Meth.and Bank Dets.
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_CALC                   Loan Calculation                                            .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_COND                   Condition Data                                              .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_MAP_CALC               Mapping for Loan Calculation                                .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_MAP_CALC_RESP          Mapping for Response of Loan Calculation                    .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_MAP_CREA               Mapping for Loan Creation                                   .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_MD                     Product Data                                                .
IF_EX_FVD_LOS                  I HANDLE_PARTNER                Business Partner Data                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I CHECK_DISBURSEMENT            Check Disbursement Data                                     .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I CUSTOMER_SPECIFIC_CONDITIONS  Set Customer-Specific Conditions                            .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I EVENT_SAVE_LOAN               Event - Contract Is Being Saved                             .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I EVENT_SAVE_LOAN_ADD_MESSAGES  Event - Contract Is Being Saved. Add Messages               .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I EVENT_SAVE_LOAN_BEFORE        Event - Before Calling FVD_MD_MAPI_CONSUMER_LOAN            .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I GET_FILE_NUMBER               Determine File Number                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_MODEL             I GET_VALID_DATE_MODELCALC      Determine Validity Date for Saved Model Calculation         .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_PRODUCT_ATTR      I SELECT_VERSION_ATTR           Selection of Attributes from Current or Contract Version    .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I ATTACHMENTLIST_EVENT          Event - Entry Selected from Attachment List                 .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I F4_CONTRACT_EVENT             Event - F4 Help Was Selected                                .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I INITIALIZE                    Event - Context Changed. Data Initialization                .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I MENU_EVENT                    Event - Menu Option Was Selected                            .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I MODIFY_ATTACHMENTLIST         Change Attachment List                                      .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I PRINT_EVENT                   Event - Model Calculation Is Output                         .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I REGISTER_F4_CONTRACT          Field List with Customer-Specific F4 Help                   .
IF_EX_FVD_MD_VIEW              I SET_MENU_ITEMS_NOT_AVAILABLE  Visibility of Menu Options                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_DBU_VDNOTEPAYEE   Transfer of Note to Payee Data to Update Task               .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_OL_CHECK_ACTIVE   Check Whether Extended Note to Payee is Active              .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_OL_DISPL_FIELDS   xxx                                                         .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_OL_SAVE           Save Global Note to Payee Table for Function Group FVDA     .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_OL_STORE_FIELDS   Save Field Content for Change Checks                        .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_UI_PROC_UCOMM     Processing of User Entries                                  .
IF_EX_FVD_NOTEPAY_OL           I FVD_NOTEPAY_UI_SETTINGS       Settings for Interfaces and Initialization Object Layer     .
IF_EX_FVD_PAYRQ                I GET_CENTRAL_BANK_DETAILS      Enter Central Bank Data                                     .
IF_EX_FVD_PAYRQ                I GET_PAYRQ_ACCOUNT             Determine Clearing Account for Payment Requests             .
IF_EX_FVD_PAYRQ                I GET_VBUND                     Enter Partner Company                                       .
IF_EX_FVD_PAY_IS_PAYOFF        I PAYOFF_DETERMINATION          Method for Determining Whether Payment Triggers a Payoff    .
IF_EX_FVD_PAY_STOP_FILE        I WRITE_TO_FILE                 Creation of a Stop File (Lockbox Procedure)                 .
IF_EX_FVD_RECON_FI             I CHANGE_BALANCE                Change Balance                                              .
IF_EX_FVD_REVERSAL_REASON      I REVERSAL_REASON               Assignment of External Reversal Reasons to Internal Reasons .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_CHECK_ACTIVE     Localization Active                                         .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_CHECK_ACT_LOAN   Localization Active for an Individual Loan                  .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_CHECK_PREP_CONDP Query Whether Condition Item is to be Changed               .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_CLEAR_REINH      Override Conventional Rounding Unit                         .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_CLEAR_ROUND_KK_KPDelete Rndg Unit and Rndg Rule During Save if not Activated .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_COPY_CONDP       Copy Condition Item                                         .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_PREP_CONDH       Default Setting Rounding Parameters Condition Header        .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_PREP_CONDP       Default Setting Rounding Parameters Condition Item          .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_PREP_CONDP_SNG   Default Setting Rounding Parameters Individual Condition    .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_ROUND_ACCO_OFFSETRounding During Account Clearing                            .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_ROUND_AMOUNT     Rounding FIMA Amount                                        .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_ROUND_IOA        Rounding of Dunning and Interest on Arrears                 .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_ROUND_IOA_NEW    Rounding of Dunning and Interest on Arrears                 .
IF_EX_FVD_ROUND_OL             I FVD_ROUND_OL_ROUND_PAYSPLIT   Rounding in Payment Split                                   .
IF_EX_FVD_TOTALCOMMIT_GET      I HANDLE_EXTENSIONS             Handle Extensions                                           .
IF_EX_FVD_US_IPD_PLAN          I OVERRIDE_PLANID               Override Payment Plan ID                                    .
IF_EX_FVFZ                     I CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_CHECK       Replacement of Function Module CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_CHECK      .
IF_EX_FVFZ                     I CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_PAYMENTS    Replacement of Function Module  CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_PAYMENTS  .
IF_EX_FVFZ                     I CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_SEARCH      Replacement of Function Module CONTRACT_CUSTOMER_SEARCH     .
IF_EX_FVVD_ARCHIV              I SET_D_ARC                     Set Archiving Key Date for Loan                             .
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I CHANGE_PROJECT_DEFINITION     Change Description of the Project Definition                .
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I CHANGE_WBS_ELEMENT            Change Description of the PSP Element                       .
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I GET_COSTING_CHARACTERISTIC    Determine Characteristics to Determine Acct Asst Element    .
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I GET_INVOICE_CHARACTERISTIC    Determine Characteristics to Determine Billing Element      .
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I GET_PROJECT_DEFINITION        Determine the Name and Description of the Project Definition.
IF_EX_GCC_PS_PROJECT_LABEL     I GET_WBS_ELEMENT               Determine Name and Description of PSP Element               .
IF_EX_GDS_MATERIAL_EXTRACT     I ADDITIONAL_SELECTIONS         Additional Selection Criteria                               .
IF_EX_GDS_MATERIAL_EXTRACT     I SEND_IDOC_COMPLETE            Send Complete IDocs                                         .
IF_EX_GEN_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL      I GET_JCO_RFC_DESTINATION       Set RFC Destionation of FCO-RFC Server                      .
IF_EX_GEN_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL      I GET_NOTIFICATION_TYPE         Set Notification Type                                       .
IF_EX_GEN_EBPP_DEBITOR_SL      I QUERY_DEBITOR                 Find Possible Customers                                     .
IF_EX_GET_CCS_PROPOSAL         I GET_CCS                       Export Default Cost Component Split                         .
IF_EX_GET_CCS_PROPOSAL         I GET_CCS_TYPES                 List of Possible Cost Component Split Types                 .
IF_EX_GET_CRM_OBJECT_TYPE      I GET_TYPE                      Method for Determining CRM_OBJECT_TYPE                      .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I BADI_ACTIVITY                 Control Calling of Methid GET_DEFCCS                        .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I GET_DEFCCS                    Modify Actual Cost Component Split                          .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I MOD_ACTIVITY_CCS              Mod. Split of an Activity Type (Multi-Level Price Determ.)  .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I MOD_CCS                       Modify Actual Cost Component Split                          .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I MOD_HRKFT_KSTAR               Modify Origin Group and Cost Element                        .
IF_EX_GET_DEFCCS               I MOD_REVAL_CCS                 Mod. Revaluation Split for ML Closing Entry                 .
IF_EX_GET_PARTN_ROLES_PPF      I GET_PARTNER_ROLES             Delivers the Possible Partner of an Application             .
IF_EX_GLT0_AFTERSPLIT_VAL      I VAL_EXECUTE                   Validation After Document Splitting                         .
IF_EX_GLT0_CLEARING_ITEMS      I ADJUST_CLEARINGS              Adjustment to Clearing Lines                                .
IF_EX_GLT0_CLEARING_ITEMS      I CLEAR_ASSGNMT                 Deletion of Superfluous Account Assignments                 .
IF_EX_GLT0_COMPLETE_ASGMT      I ALTER_EXISTING_VALUES         Permitted to Change Coding?                                 .
IF_EX_GLT0_COMPLETE_ASGMT      I CHANGE_ASSIGNMENT             Change Coding Within Active Split                           .
IF_EX_GLT0_COMPLETE_ASGMT      I COMPLETE_ASSIGNMENT           Set Coding in Base Rows                                     .
IF_EX_GLT0_COMPLETE_ASGMT      I SUBSTITUTE_ASSIGNMENT         Set Coding After Passive Split                              .
IF_EX_GLT0_REPLACE_ASGMT       I REPLACE_ASSIGNMENT            Replace Coding Before Posting                               .
IF_EX_GM_ALLOW_FM_PLANNING     I ACTIVATE_GRANT_FOR_FM_PLANNINGActivate Grant for FM Planning                              .
IF_EX_GM_AUTHORITY_CHECK       I BUDGET_CHECK                  User authorization check for budget document                .
IF_EX_GM_AUTHORITY_CHECK       I GRANT_CHECK                   User authorization check for grant                          .
IF_EX_GM_AUTHORITY_CHECK       I SPONSORED_CLASS_CHECK         User authorization check for sponsored class                .
IF_EX_GM_AUTHORITY_CHECK       I SPONSORED_PROGRAM_CHECK       User authorization check for sponsored program              .
IF_EX_GM_BDGT_FM_SOURCE        I EVALUATE_BUDGET_SOURCE        Evaluate and change budget source depending on values       .
IF_EX_GM_BDGT_TRFR             I TRFR_LINES_CHECK_MODIFY       Transfer Lines check or modify                              .
IF_EX_GM_BDGT_VALIDATIONS      I CUSTOM_CHECK                  Custom Check                                                .
IF_EX_GM_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES             Change Stat. Indicator and Derivation Strategy for Account  .
IF_EX_GM_CHANGE_STATUS         I GM_CHANGE_STATUS              Option to override or reject next state                     .
IF_EX_GM_COPY_GRANT            I GM_COPY_GRANT                 Replacement for the default copy from routine               .
IF_EX_GM_GENERATE_AUTH_GRP     I GET_AUTH_GRP_CLASS            Generate authorization group for a Sponsored Class          .
IF_EX_GM_GENERATE_AUTH_GRP     I GET_AUTH_GRP_GRANT            Generate authorization group for a Grant                    .
IF_EX_GM_GENERATE_AUTH_GRP     I GET_AUTH_GRP_PROGRAM          Generate authorization group for a Sponsored Program        .
IF_EX_GM_GRANT_NBR             I GM_GRANT_NBR_MODIFY           Allows grant number modification for external assignment    .
IF_EX_GM_IDCPOST               I FILL_CO_OBJECTS               Fill CO objects                                             .
IF_EX_GM_OM_EXT_CHK            I DO_CHECK                      Are checks disabled                                         .
IF_EX_GM_OM_EXT_CHK            I RUN_MORE_CHECKS               Run more checks                                             .
IF_EX_GM_POSTING_CONTROL       I OVERRIDE_POSTING_CONTROLS     Override Posting Controls                                   .
IF_EX_GM_POST_AUTHORITY        I CHECK_AUTHORITY               BAdi for Authrority Check                                   .
IF_EX_GM_RM_INTEGRATION        I SET_VISIBILITY                Set Visibility Parameters for elements                      .
IF_EX_GM_SALES_ORDER_EXT       I GM_SALES_ORDER_EXT            Maps grant fields to sales order fields                     .
IF_EX_GM_SD_ORDER_CREATE       I GM_SD_ORDER_CREATE            Called instead of the default routine for SD order creation .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I EXIT_PAI_CLASS                User-exit PAI Sponsored Class                               .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I EXIT_PAI_PROGRAM              User-exit PAI Sponsored Program                             .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I EXIT_PBO_CLASS                User-exit PBO Sponsored Class                               .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I EXIT_PBO_PROGRAM              User-exit PBO Sponsored Program                             .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I GET_DATA_SCREEN_CLASS         Get data from the Screen Class                              .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I GET_DATA_SCREEN_PROGRAM       Get data from the Screen Program                            .
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I PUT_DATA_ON_SCREEN_CLASS      Copy data to screen to make it available on Screen for Class.
IF_EX_GM_SPONSOREDOBJ          I PUT_DATA_ON_SCREEN_PROGRAM    Copy data to screen to make it available on Screen for Prog..
IF_EX_GM_STRATEGY_DERIVE       I GET_STRATEGY                  Derive Strategy for the GM Derivation Tool                  .
IF_EX_GOS_MULT_PUBLISH         I ADD_OBJECTS                   Add Objects for Publication                                 .
IF_EX_GOS_SRV_REQUEST          I START_SERVICE                 Start Service                                               .
IF_EX_GOS_SRV_SELECT           I SELECT_SERVICES               Service Selection                                           .
IF_EX_GRID_CLICK_PPF           I CHECK_DOUBLE_CLICK            Is Double-Click on these Field Names Edited?                .
IF_EX_GRID_CLICK_PPF           I HANDLE_DOUBLE_CLICK           Edit Double-Click on Cell                                   .
IF_EX_GUI_APPL_OBJ_OHFW        I CHANGE_FIELD_ATTRIB           Change the field attributes                                 .
IF_EX_GUI_APPL_OBJ_OHFW        I GET_NODE_ATTRIBUTES           Get the node attributes                                     .
IF_EX_GUI_APPL_OBJ_OHFW        I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Get the subscreen                                           .
IF_EX_GUI_APPL_OBJ_OHFW        I HANDLE_CANCEL                 Handle cancel                                               .
IF_EX_GUI_ASSIGNMENTS_RFW      I GET_ALV_LAYOUT                Get Output Format                                           .
IF_EX_GUI_ASSIGNMENTS_RFW      I GET_HEADER_INFO               ALV Tree Header                                             .
IF_EX_GUI_ASSIGNMENTS_RFW      I GET_TOOLBAR_FCODES            Get Function Codes for Toolbar                              .
IF_EX_GUI_BROWSER_OHFW         I BUILD_MENU                    Builds up a menu on toolbar dropdown                        .
IF_EX_GUI_BROWSER_OHFW         I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Changes the fieldcatalog                                    .
IF_EX_GUI_BROWSER_OHFW         I CHANGE_TOOLBAR                Changes the toolbar                                         .
IF_EX_GUI_BROWSER_OHFW         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks authorization for activity on node                   .
IF_EX_GUI_BROWSER_OHFW         I GET_STATUS                    Gets the status                                             .
IF_EX_GUI_DETAIL_RFW           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get control attributes for detail/comparison screens        .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_COPY                    Preprocessing and prerequisites check for COPY              .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_COPY_COMPLETE           Postprocessing for COPY                                     .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_CUT                     Preprocessing and prerequisites check for CUT               .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_CUT_COMPLETE            Postprocessing for CUT                                      .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_NEW                     Preprocessing and prerequisites check for NEW               .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_NEW_COMPLETE            Postprocessing for NEW                                      .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_PASTE                   Preprocessing and prerequisites check for PASTE             .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I CHECK_PASTE_COMPLETE          Postprocessing for PASTE                                    .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I DETAIL                        Detail the selected nodes                                   .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_ALV_LAYOUT                Get Layout for ALV tree                                     .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_ALV_VARIANTS              Get ALV variants                                            .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_GRAPH_ATTRIBUTES          Get general attributes for graph display                    .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_HEADER_INFO               Get the information about the header's element              .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_TOOLBAR_FCODES            Get the toolbar function codes                              .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_UDEF_MENU_ITEM            Get the user's defined context menu triggered on item click .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_UDEF_MENU_NODE            Get the user's defined context menu triggered on node click .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I GET_UDEF_TOOLBAR              Get the function codes for user's defined toolbar           .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I HANDLE_UDEF_FUNCTIONS         User's defined functionalities handler                      .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE              Overdefinition of processing ALV event ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE     .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I ON_DROP                       Overdefinition of processing ALV event ON_DROP              .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I ON_DROP_COMPLETE_MULTIPLE     Overdefinition of processing ALV event ON_DROP_COMPLETE     .
IF_EX_GUI_GRAPH_RFW            I SET_OPTIMIZATION_MODE         Set the optimization level                                  .
IF_EX_GUI_ITEMIZATION_CK       I ON_FIELCATALOG_CREATE         ALV Display of Enhancements of the Cost Estimate Structure  .
IF_EX_GUI_ITEMIZATION_CK       I ON_ITEM_INPUT                 Special processing if costing item has been changed         .
IF_EX_GUI_NAVIGATION_RFW       I GET_ALV_LAYOUT                Get Output Format                                           .
IF_EX_GUI_NAVIGATION_RFW       I GET_ALV_VARIANTS              Get ALV Variants                                            .
IF_EX_GUI_NAVIGATION_RFW       I GET_HEADER_INFO               ALV Tree Header                                             .
IF_EX_GUI_NAVIGATION_RFW       I GET_TOOLBAR_FCODES            Get Function Codes for Toolbar                              .
IF_EX_GUI_PROTOCOL_OHFW        I GET_DISPLAY_FILTER            Gets the display filter                                     .
IF_EX_GUI_PROTOCOL_OHFW        I GET_DISPLAY_PROFILE           Gets the display profile                                    .
IF_EX_GUI_RFW                  I GET_HEADER_INFO               Infos for Header Area                                       .
IF_EX_GUI_RFW                  I GET_SETTINGS                  Get Settings                                                .
IF_EX_GUI_RFW                  I GET_TOOLBAR_FCODES            Get Function Codes for Toolbar                              .
IF_EX_GUI_RFW                  I GET_UDEF_TOOLBAR              User defined functions for toolbar                          .
IF_EX_GUI_RFW                  I HANDLE_UDEF_FUNCTIONS         Handle the user defined functions.                          .
IF_EX_G_MODIFY_TABLE           I MODIFY_TABLE                  Change Line Item Table Before Update                        .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHANGE_FIELDCAT        Change the field cat. of the fields you can add to a layout .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHANGE_TEXT_KEY        Change the key of the texts                                 .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHECK_COMBINATION      Checks in Form ec501_check_combination                      .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHECK_DATA             Check data to be posted                                     .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHECK_FIRST_SCREEN     Check entries of first selection screen snd send message    .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_CHECK_LAYOUT           Check a layout when you create it                           .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_DEACTIVATE_SETS        Deactivate Sets for a few dimensions                        .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_ENRICH_DATA            Enrich the data to be posted                                .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_FILL_NEW_ITDAT1        Fill itdat1 depending on authorities                        .
IF_EX_G_PLANNING_EXTENSION     I G_PLAN_TEXT_HANDLER           Exit to handle texts of the cells by the application        .
IF_EX_G_SET_CHANGES            I CHANGED                       Set Was Created or Changed                                  .
IF_EX_G_SET_CHANGES            I CHILD_CHANGED                 A Subordinate Set Was Changed                               .
IF_EX_G_SET_CHANGES            I DELETED                       Set Was Deleted                                             .
IF_EX_G_SET_FORMULA_EXIT       I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Exit                                               .
IF_EX_G_SET_FORMULA_EXIT       I GET_TYPE                      Determine Attributes of the Exit                            .
IF_EX_G_SET_STD_HIERARCHY      I GET                           Standard Hierarchy for Set Class and Organizational Unit    .
IF_EX_G_SET_STD_HIERARCHY      I GET_ALL                       All Standard Hierarchies of Set Class                       .
IF_EX_G_SET_USAGE              I CHECK                         Check Whether a Set Is Used                                 .
IF_EX_G_SET_USAGE              I DISPLAY                       Display Object Used (Dialog Method)                         .
IF_EX_G_SET_USAGE              I LIST                          List of Usages of a Set                                     .
IF_EX_HBS01                    I CHECK_PROPERTY_MASTER         Check Property Master                                       .
IF_EX_HIERARCHY_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Hierarchy/Category Was Created or Changed                   .
IF_EX_HIER_CHECK_LBK           I CHECK_NODE_ACTION             Performs checks for LBK node actions (create/delete/change) .
IF_EX_HIER_CHECK_OHFW          I CHECK_NODE_ACTION             Performs checks for OHF node actions (create/delete/change) .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ001           I SET_FORM_SPLITS               Set form splits according key field values                  .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ002           I SET_DAQ_SPLIT                 Set DAQ for form split                                      .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ003           I CHECK_PERIOD_RELEVANT         Check if payroll period is relevant                         .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ004           I UPDATE_VALUE_AMTFO            Update value table for wage types                           .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ005           I SUM_PERIODS_VALUE             Sum values of several periods                               .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ006           I CHECK_PAYROLL                 Check payroll results                                       .
IF_EX_HR99S00_DAQ007           I MODIFY_VALUES                 Modify the values read by the table reader                  .
IF_EX_HRALE00CHANGE_PTRS       I PROCESS_CHANGE_POINTERS       Processing of Change Pointers (After Standard Processing)   .
IF_EX_HRALE00CHANGE_PTRS       I SET_LAST_CHANGE               Processing of Change Pointers (Before Standard Processing)  .
IF_EX_HRALE00CHANGE_PTRS_I     I PROCESS_CHANGE_POINTERS       Processing of Change Pointers (After Standard Processing)   .
IF_EX_HRALE00CHANGE_PTRS_I     I SET_LAST_CHANGE               Processing of Change Pointers (Before Standard Processing)  .
IF_EX_HRALE00INBOUND_IDOC      I IDOC_STATUS_PROCESS           Work through list of status records                         .
IF_EX_HRALE00INBOUND_IDOC      I PROCESS_IDOC                  User-Defined Inbound Processing; Can Replace The Standard   .
IF_EX_HRALE00INBOUND_IDOC      I SET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Set Output Parameters for FM IDOC_INPUT_HRMD                .
IF_EX_HRALE00INBOUND_OBJEC     I CHECK_OBJECT                  Determine Whether Object is Permitted for Inbound Processing.
IF_EX_HRALE00INB_DATA_READ     I ALL_OBJECTS_READ              Read Access to All Objects in ALE Inbound Processing        .
IF_EX_HRALE00ORIGSYSTEM        I OTYPE_HAS_ORIGINAL            Change Table of Object Types With Original System Relevance .
IF_EX_HRALE00ORIGSYSTEM        I SAVE_DATA_FOR_ORIGINAL        Read Specific Objects Although Original in Target System    .
IF_EX_HRALE00ORIGSYSTEM        I WRITE_CHGPTR_FOR_REPLICA      Write Change Pointers for Specific Replications             .
IF_EX_HRALE00OUTBOUND_I        I DEACTIVATE_CHECK              Deactivation of Standard Checks                             .
IF_EX_HRALE00OUTBOUND_I        I IDOC_DATA_FOR_RECEIVER_MODIFY Modify IDoc Data Based on Recipient                         .
IF_EX_HRALE00OUTBOUND_IDOC     I DEACTIVATE_CHECK              Modify IDoc Data Based on Recipient                         .
IF_EX_HRALE00OUTBOUND_IDOC     I FILTER_VALUES_SET             Setting Filter Values for Generic Filtering                 .
IF_EX_HRALE00OUTBOUND_IDOC     I IDOC_DATA_FOR_RECEIVER_MODIFY Modify IDoc Data Based on Recipient                         .
IF_EX_HRALE00SPLIT_INBOUND     I PROCESS_SELECTED_DATA         Inbound Processing for Selected Data                        .
IF_EX_HRALE00SPLIT_INBOUND     I SELECT_DATA                   Selection of Plan Version/Obj.Type/Obj.ID for Processing    .
IF_EX_HRALEX_INBOUND           I ADD_ADDITIONAL_SEGMENTS       Add Additional Segments                                     .
IF_EX_HRALEX_INBOUND           I MODIFY_E1PITYP                Change E1PITYP                                              .
IF_EX_HRALX_ADDRESS_CHNGD      I BPBP_ADDRESS_CHANGED          Address of BP(P) -BP(O) Relationship Changed                .
IF_EX_HRALX_HRALXSYNC_BADI     I GRID_EVENT_DOUBLE_CLICK       HRALXSYNC: Event Double-Click on ALV Grid                   .
IF_EX_HRALX_HRALXSYNC_BADI     I RECONC_SEL_OBJ                HRALXSYNC: Repair and Edit Selected Objects                 .
IF_EX_HRALX_HRALXSYNC_BADI     I SEL_ANALY_OBJ                 HRALXSYNC: Select and Analyze Objects                       .
IF_EX_HRBAS00INFTY             I AFTER_INPUT                   Call-Up Time PAI                                            .
IF_EX_HRBAS00INFTY             I BEFORE_OUTPUT                 Call-Up Time PBO                                            .
IF_EX_HRBAS00INFTY             I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Call-Up Before Update                                       .
IF_EX_HRBAS00INFTY             I IN_UPDATE                     Call-Up During Update                                       .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_GET_PROFL        I GET_T77PR_TAB                 Determine user profile from table T77PR                     .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_INFTY            I AFTER_INPUT                   Call-Up Time PAI                                            .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_INFTY            I BEFORE_OUTPUT                 Call-Up Time PBO                                            .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_INFTY            I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Call-Up Before Update                                       .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_INFTY            I IN_UPDATE                     Call-Up During Update                                       .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_OM_DEL_CHECK     I SET_EVALUATION_PATH           Determine Evaluation Path for Test Before Deletion          .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_RELAT            I MAINTAIN_RELATION             Maintain Relationship (or Change HRI1001)                   .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_RHBAUS00         I MODIFY_VIEW_RHBAUS            Change VIEW Table                                           .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SEARCH           I GET_OBJ_LIST_SHLP             Get Search Help for Displaying Object List                  .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SEARCH           I GET_TOP_SHLP                  Get Higher Level Search Help                                .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SEARCH           I OBJID_CHECK                   Composite Definition for Object Check (RH_MACO)             .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SEARCH           I OBJID_F4                      Composite Definition for Value Help (RH_OBJID_REQUEST)      .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SEARCH_EXCL      I EXCLUDE_SEARCHHELPS           Exclude Search Help (Not Displayed in F4)                   .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_SELECTION        I TRANSFORM_SELECTIONS          Conversion of Selection Criteria                            .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_T77S0            I CHECK_VALUE                   Check Value (PAI)                                           .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_T77S0            I GET_DDIC_REFERENCE            Read DDIC Reference for Switch                              .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_T77S0            I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Change Display for PBO                                      .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_T77S0            I PROCESS_F1                    Display Documentation (F1/POH)                              .
IF_EX_HRBAS00_T77S0            I PROCESS_F4                    Perform Input Help (F4/POV)                                 .
IF_EX_HRBEN00ESS0001           I ESTIMATE_CONTRIBUTION_MISCEL  Estimation of Contributions for Miscellaneous Plans         .
IF_EX_HRBEN00ESS0001           I ESTIMATE_CONTRIBUTION_SAVING  Estimation of Contributions for Savings Plans               .
IF_EX_HRBEN00ESS0001           I ESTIMATE_CONTRIBUTION_STOCKP  Estimation of Contributions for Stock Purchase Plans        .
IF_EX_HRBEN00ESS0002           I FILL_PLAN_COST_INFO           Filling of 'Costs' and 'Remarks' Columns                    .
IF_EX_HRBEN00PAY0013           I READ_CUMUL_RESULTS            Read cumulated payroll results for Compensation Management  .
IF_EX_HRBEN00RET0001           I EXTRACT_PAYROLL_CUMULATIONS   Extract cumulated payroll results for retirement plans      .
IF_EX_HRBEN00RET0002           I FILL_ACCUM_AMOUNTS_SEGMENT    Fill IDOC segment "Cumulated amounts"                       .
IF_EX_HRBEN00TCS0001           I BEN_TCS_DATA_READ             Read Customer-Specific Benefits Data                        .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I GET_COMPENSATION_DAYS         Gets status for compensation days (Paid / Unpaid)           .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I GET_CO_REDUC_PLAN             Gets Enterprise reduction plan                              .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_CATEGORY                  Sets employee category (blue collars=1 / white collars =2)  .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_MANDT                     Sets client                                                 .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_PERIOD                    Sets period so SI contributions                             .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_PERNR                     Sets Personnel number attribute                             .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_PERS_AREA                 Sets Personnel Area attribute                               .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_PERS_SUB_AREA             Sets Personnel Sub-area attribute                           .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_SI_CAT_EMPLOYEE           Sets Social Insurance employee category                     .
IF_EX_HRBE_EDU_LEAVE           I SET_SI_CAT_EMPLOYER           Sets Social Insurance employer category                     .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Authorization Check for Selected Records                    .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I EDIT_SELECTION                Change Number of Records to be Approved                     .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I FILL_COMPARATIVE_COLUMNS      Determine Values for Comparison Columns                     .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I FILL_TEXT_COLUMN_CONS         Enter Text for Message Column (Collective Approval View)    .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I FILL_TEXT_COLUMN_SINGL        Enter Text for Message Column (Individual Approval View)    .
IF_EX_HRCATS_APPR_CUST         I GET_PROFILE_ID                Determine Approver Profile                                  .
IF_EX_HRCCE_DIST               I METHOD                        Implement additional distribution methods                   .
IF_EX_HRCCE_PAYMENT            I BANK_TRANSFER                 Process bank transfer                                       .
IF_EX_HRCCE_PAYMENT            I CREATE_WAGETYPE               Create wage type from bank transfer amount                  .
IF_EX_HRCCE_PAYMENT            I PCL24                         Addtl. country-specific specification of processing class 24.
IF_EX_HRCCE_RETRO              I PROC_WT                       Process wage type with processing class 23                  .
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I CHECK_PARAMETER_EXISTS        Checks whether values are maintained on the screen          .
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I GET_BUDGETVALUES              Determine Values for Budget Structure                       .
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I GET_SCREEN                    Determine Program/Screen for Parameters Subscreen           .
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I INITIALIZATION                Initialization Event Before Each Subscreen Call             .
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I SET_PARAMETERS                Alternative to SET_VARIANTS that transfers parameters direct.
IF_EX_HRCMP00BGT0001           I SET_VARIANT_VALUES            Transfer Variants for Subscreen Parameters                  .
IF_EX_HRCMP00COMPA_RATIO       I GET_REFERENCE_SALARY          Determine the Reference Salary                              .
IF_EX_HRCMP00SAL0001           I CHANGE_SALARY_DATA            Change Salary Data                                          .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0001           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data for Person for SAP-Defined Subcategory   .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0002           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data of Person for Customer-Defined Subcat.   .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0003           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data for Person for SAP-Defined Subcategory   .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0004           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data of Person for Customer-Defined Subcat.   .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0005           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data of Person for Customer-Defined Category  .
IF_EX_HRCMP00TCS0006           I TCS_AUTH_CHECK                TCS Authority Check                                         .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_ECM_ACCOUNT      I GET_DATA_FOR_ACCOUNTING       Collects LTI Data for Accounting                            .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_ECM_PAYROLL      I GET_DATA_FOR_PAYROLL          Collects LTI Data for Payroll                               .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_ECM_TCS          I GET_DATA_FOR_TCS              Collects LTI Data for Total Compensation Statement          .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I AFTER_RECLASSIFICATION        Process After Reclassification                              .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I APPEND_ALV_OUTPUT_DATA        Complete List of Displayed Data (ALV)                       .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I CHANGE_BATCH_INPUT_DATA       Make Changes to Batch Input Session                         .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I CHANGE_RECLASSIFICATION_DATE  Process After Determination of Reclassification Date        .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I CHOOSE_RECLASSIFICATION_TYPES Process for Selecting Reclassification Types                .
IF_EX_HRCMP00_PS_RECL          I DO_RECLASSIFICATION           Process Instead of Standard Reclassification                .
IF_EX_HRECM00_ACTIVATION       I ACTIVATE_PROCESS              Replace creation/update of secondary infotype               .
IF_EX_HRECM00_ACTIVATION       I CALC_SAL_ADJUSTMENT           Replace calculation of new IT 0008 record                   .
IF_EX_HRECM00_AGEDATA          I AGE_MARKET_DATA               Aging Survey Market Data                                    .
IF_EX_HRECM00_BDG0001          I DETERMINE_BUDGET_VALUES       Determine budget values for update infotype 1520            .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CALCBASE         I GET_CALCULATION_BASE          Evaluate the calculation base salary                        .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CARGP            I READ_FEATURE_CARGP            Determine compensation area                                 .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CONSISTENCY      I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Define additional tests for consistency check               .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CP1GP            I READ_FEATURE_CP1GP            Determine first compensation program grouping               .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CP2GP            I READ_FEATURE_CP2GP            Determine second compensation program grouping              .
IF_EX_HRECM00_CRS              I GET_CRS_DATA                  Get all relevant Comp. Review Statement data                .
IF_EX_HRECM00_EFFDATE          I GET_DEFAULT_EFF_DATE          Determination of default effective date                     .
IF_EX_HRECM00_ELIGIBILITY      I CHECK_ELIGIBILITY             Replace complete eligibility check                          .
IF_EX_HRECM00_ELIGIBILITY      I CHECK_MICRO_ELIGIBILITY       Define additional elig. criteria, change end of waiting prd..
IF_EX_HRECM00_ELIGIBILITY      I GET_PROGRAM_PERIOD            Replace evaluation of program period                        .
IF_EX_HRECM00_ELIGP            I READ_FEATURE_ELIGP            Determine eligibility grouping                              .
IF_EX_HRECM00_EXERCISE         I IDOC_STATUS_PROCESS           Work through list of status records                         .
IF_EX_HRECM00_EXERCISE         I PROCESS_IDOC                  User-Defined Inbound Processing; Can Replace The Standard   .
IF_EX_HRECM00_EXERCISE         I SET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Set Output Parameters for FM HRECM00_PROCESS_EXERCISE_IDOC  .
IF_EX_HRECM00_GDEGP            I READ_FEATURE_GDEGP            Determine guideline grouping                                .
IF_EX_HRECM00_GRANT_INFO       I GET_LTI_GRANT_INFO            Get all relevant LTI grants information                     .
IF_EX_HRECM00_GUIDELINE        I EVALUATE_GDL_CONTRIB          Manipulate guideline contribution result                    .
IF_EX_HRECM00_GUIDELINE        I EVALUATE_GUIDELINE            Replace complete guideline evaluation                       .
IF_EX_HRECM00_MATRIX_SEGM      I CALCULATE_SEGMENT_VALUE       Calculate value of the method for an employee               .
IF_EX_HRECM00_MATRIX_SEGM      I CHECK_PARAMETER               Value check for the generic dimension parameter             .
IF_EX_HRECM00_MATRIX_SEGM      I CHECK_UNIT                    Value check for the dimension unit                          .
IF_EX_HRECM00_MATRIX_SEGM      I F4_HELP_FOR_PARAMETER         F4 help for the generic dimension parameter                 .
IF_EX_HRECM00_MATRIX_SEGM      I F4_HELP_FOR_UNIT              F4 help for the dimension unit                              .
IF_EX_HRECM00_PARTICIPANT      I GET_EMPLOYEE_ADDITIONAL_INFO  Get additional information about the employee               .
IF_EX_HRECM00_PARTICIPANT      I GET_EMPLOYEE_CONTACT_INFO     Get contact information about the employee                  .
IF_EX_HRECM00_PARTICIPANT      I GET_EMPLOYEE_NAME_INFO        Get all information about the name of the employee          .
IF_EX_HRECM00_PARTICIPANT      I GET_EMPLOYEE_POSTAL_ADDRESS   Get all information about post address of the employee      .
IF_EX_HRECM00_PARTICIPANT      I GET_EMPLOYEE_TAX_INFO         Get all relevant tax information about the employee         .
IF_EX_HRECM00_SALARY           I CALCULATE_SALARY              Calculate employee salary                                   .
IF_EX_HRECM00_SALARY           I CALC_COMPA_RATIO              Calculate compa-ratio                                       .
IF_EX_HRECM00_SALARY           I CALC_PERCENT_IN_RANGE         Calculate percent-in-range                                  .
IF_EX_HRECM00_STATSTYPE        I GET_VALUE_FOR_STATSTYPE       Calculates the value for a statistical paygroup             .
IF_EX_HRECM00_STATSTYPE        I GET_VALUE_HANDLER             Who (customer or standard) handles the value determination  .
IF_EX_HRECM00_STKUN            I GET_CITEM_STKUN               Determine stock unit for review item                        .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_DATA_IMPORT             Time After Importing Basic Data. Additional Actions         .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_DELETE                  Time After Deleting Profile. Additional Actions             .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_DEQ                     Time After Unlocking Profile. Additional Actions            .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_ENQ                     Time After Locking Profile. Additional Actions              .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_SAVE                    Time After Saving Profile. Additional Actions               .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_SEARCH                  Time After Search Query. Check and Filter Results List      .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I AFTER_UPLOAD_PHOTO            Time After Saving Photo. Additional Actions                 .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_DATA_IMPORT            Time Before Importing Basic Data. Initial Steps             .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_DELETE                 Time Before Deleting Profile. Check Profile                 .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_DEQ                    Time Before Unlocking Profile. Check Profile                .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_ENQ                    Time Before Locking Profile. Check Profile                  .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_SAVE                   Time Before Saving Profile. Check and Complete Profile      .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_SEARCH                 Time Before Search Query. Check and Complete Search Query   .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I BEFORE_UPLOAD_PHOTO           Time Before Saving Photo. Check Photo                       .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I CHECK_AUTH_DETAIL             Check Authorization for Calling Expert's Detail Screen      .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I CHECK_AUTH_PROF               Check Authorization for Calling Expert Profile              .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I CHECK_AUTH_SCENARIO           Check Authorization for Calling Search                      .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I CHECK_LDAP_ENTRIES            Check Entries in LDAP Directory of Expert                   .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_ELEMENT_ACTION            Determine Additional Actions for Element                    .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_EXPERT_ID_FROM_LDAP_KEY   Determine Experts for LDAP Key                              .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_EXPERT_ID_FROM_UNAME      Determine Expert ID from User Name                          .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_HR_OBJECT_FROM_EXPERT_ID  Determine HR Object for Experts                             .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_LDAP_KEY_FROM_EXPERT_ID   Determine LDAP Key for Experts                              .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_PROFTYPES                 Determine Expert Profile Types of Expert                    .
IF_EX_HREXP_EXPERT             I GET_SEARCHSCENARIOS           Determine Search Scenarios for Expert                       .
IF_EX_HRFORM_AFTER_TRANSP      I ACTIVATE_FORMS                Activate Forms                                              .
IF_EX_HRFORM_BUSINESS_ADRS     I MAKE_ADDRESS                  Format a Business Address                                   .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I AFTER_PDF_PRINT               Operations Immediately After PDF Print                      .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I BEFORE_PDF_PRINT              Operations Immediately Before PDF Print                     .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I CHECK_PERNR                   Check 1 if PNR is Rejected or Skipped in Form               .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I CHECK_PERNR_LATE              Check 1 if PNR is Rejected or Skipped in Form               .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I CHECK_PERSON                  Check 1, whether PERSON in form is rejected or skipped      .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I CHECK_PERSON_LATE             Check 1, whether PERSON in form is rejected or skipped      .
IF_EX_HRFORM_HRF02             I SET_ARCHIVE_INDEX             Determine Key for Optical Archiving of Forms                .
IF_EX_HRFORM_METADATA          I CHANGE_PAYROLL_SPLITS         Edit Relationships Between Payroll Tables                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT                I EXTEND_ADTKEY                 Revision of Job Index Key                                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT                I EXTEND_F4                     Extension of Permitted Job Index Key                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT                I EXTEND_OBJECTDATA             Enhancement of Transfer Structure                           .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT                I GET_ADTKEY                    Determining Job Title Key                                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT_SUB_SCR        I GET_0783_DATA_FROM_SCREEN     Import Data for Processing of IT 0783                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT_SUB_SCR        I GET_1513_DATA_FROM_SCREEN     Import Data for Processing of IT 1513                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT_SUB_SCR        I PUT_0783_DATA_TO_SCREEN       Export Data for Processing of IT 0783                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ADT_SUB_SCR        I PUT_1513_DATA_TO_SCREEN       Export Data for Processing of IT 1513                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_BC_RELEVANCE       I CHECK_BUDGET_CHART_RELEVANCE  Check whether an account assignment                         .
IF_EX_HRFPM_BUDGET_CHART       I EXTEND_BUDGET_CHART           Enhancement of Personnel Budget Plan                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_BU_EXTENSIONS      I GET_BULIST_EXT                Extension of Position Analysis                              .
IF_EX_HRFPM_BU_EXTENSIONS      I GET_FINLIST_EXT               Extension of Financing Analysis                             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_CHART_OF_RESP      I EXTEND_CHART_OF_RESPONS       Enhancement of Business Distribution Plan                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_CREATE_DOCS        I DOC_SHOW                      Display of Generated Documents                              .
IF_EX_HRFPM_CREATE_DOCS        I UPDATE_FPM_DOCS_P             Creation of Commt Docs and Transfer to Acctg for Personnel  .
IF_EX_HRFPM_CREATE_DOCS        I UPDATE_FPM_DOCS_S             Creation of Commt Docs and Transfer to Acctg for Positions  .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DATA_COLL          I COLLECT_DATA_P                Collect Data for a Person                                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DATA_COLL          I COLLECT_DATA_S                Collect Data for a Position                                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DELTA_UPD_BW       I BW_DELTA_QUEUE_WRITE_DIFF     BW Delta Updates for Table HRFPM_DIFFERENCE                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DELTA_UPD_BW       I BW_DELTA_QUEUE_WRITE_FPM_POS  BW Delta Updates for Table HRFPM_FPM_POS                    .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DIFFERENCE         I CLEAN_UP                      Process Personnel Cost Savings for Incorrect Objects        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DIFFERENCE         I LINK_DELTA_DOCUMENTS          Export of FPM Delta Documents and Transfer of FM Documents  .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DIFFERENCE         I POST_DOCUMENTS                Post Personnel Cost Savings                                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_DIFF_BUD_TRANS     I CALL_BUDGET_TRANSFER          Budget Transfer Call                                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ENCUMB_IV          I CHECK_ACC_IV                  Confirm Validity of Account Assignments (Time Dependent)    .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ENCUMB_IV          I GET_OBJECT_ENC_IV             Determine Object-Specific Commitment Interval               .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ENC_PER            I GET_ENC_PERIODS               Determine Commitment Periods                                .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_CHK_POST       I CATEGORIZE_CHECK_ERROR        Derive Error Category                                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_CHK_POST       I CHANGE_OCC_WEIGHT             Change Weighting Percentage                                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_CHK_POST       I CREATE_MESSAGE                Derive Message Texts                                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_CHK_POST       I PROCESS_ALL_RESULTS           Edit All Check Results of Financing                         .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_FILL_CHKIF     I PREPARE_BUDGET_DATA_FOR_CHK   Prepare Data of BU Object for Check                         .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_FILL_CHKIF     I PREPARE_PERSON_DATA_FOR_CHK   Prepare Data of Financing Object for Check                  .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_FILL_CHKIF     I PREPARE_POSITION_DATA_FOR_CHK Prepare Data of Financing Object for Check                  .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_LIST           I EXTEND_FIN_LIST               Enhancement Financing Per Organizational Unit               .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_PROVIDE_IT     I PROVIDE_BUDGET_INFOTYPES      Add Own Infotypes for Budget Structure Elements             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_PROVIDE_IT     I PROVIDE_PERSON_INFOTYPES      Add Own Infotypes for Person                                .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_PROVIDE_IT     I PROVIDE_POSITION_INFOTYPES    Add Own Infotypes for Position                              .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_PROVIDE_IT     I SET_OTHER_IT_READ_METHOD      Define other read modules for individual IT                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FIN_RULES_CHK      I CHECK_RELATION                Check Valuations                                            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FTE_CHK_CHART      I BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT            Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FTE_CHK_CHART      I EXTEND_HEADER_LINE            Enhance Header Line for ALV Output                          .
IF_EX_HRFPM_FTE_CHK_CHART      I EXTEND_POSITION_LINE          Enhance Item Line for ALV Output                            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_GET_DUE_DATE       I GET_DUE_DATE                  Determination of Due Date                                   .
IF_EX_HRFPM_NEG_CMMTMNT        I GET_HR_BLART_FROM_ACC_ASSGNMNTOverwrite Document Type for HR Documents                    .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OBJECT_COLL        I GET_OBJECTS                   Selection of Objects for Current Commitment Run             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT            Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I EXTEND_FTE_CHART_LINE         Extend Line for ALV Output of Financing Rules               .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I EXTEND_OCC_CHART_LINE         Extend Line for ALV Output of Staff Assignment Rules        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I EXTEND_POSITION_LINE          Enhance Line for ALV Output                                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I MODIFY_FTE_CHART              Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I MODIFY_FTE_CHART_FCAT         Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I MODIFY_OCC_CHART              Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_CHART      I MODIFY_OCC_CHART_FCAT         Immediately before the list is issued                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_POST       I CATEGORIZE_CHECK_ERROR        Derive Error Category                                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_POST       I CHANGE_OCC_WEIGHT             Change Weighting                                            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_POST       I CREATE_MESSAGE                Derive Message Texts                                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_CHK_POST       I PROCESS_ALL_RESULTS           Edit All Check Results of a Staff Assignment                .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_FILL_CHKIF     I PREPARE_FINANCEE_DATA         Prepare Employee Data for Check                             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_FILL_CHKIF     I PREPARE_FINANCING_DATA        Prepare Position Data for Check                             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_OUTPUT         I WRITE_CHECK_RESULT_IN_OVERVIEWDisplay of Check Result for Check Views                     .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_OUTPUT         I WRITE_CHECK_RESULT_IN_REPORT  Display of Check Result for Check Report                    .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_OUTPUT         I WRITE_COLLECT_RESULT_IN_OVERVWDisplay of Summarized Check Result for Check Views          .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_OUTPUT         I WRITE_COLLECT_RESULT_IN_REPORTDisplay of Summarized Check Result for Check Report         .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_OUTPUT         I WRITE_EXEMPTION_IN_REPORT     Display of Check Exception for Check Report                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_PROVIDE_IT     I PROVIDE_FINANCEE_INFOTYPES    Add Own Infotypes for Person                                .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_PROVIDE_IT     I PROVIDE_FINANCING_INFOTYPES   Add Own Infotypes for Position                              .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_PROVIDE_IT     I SET_OTHER_IT_READ_METHOD      Define other read modules for individual IT                 .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OCC_RULES_CHK      I CHECK_RELATION                Check Valuations                                            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ORIG_PLAN_VAL      I GET_ORIG_PLAN_VALUE           Determination of Planned Value                              .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ORIG_PLAN_VAL      I GET_UNIT                      Determination of Unit                                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ORIG_PLAN_VAL      I GET_VALUE_FROM_WORKTIME       Determination of Planned Value from Working Time            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ORIG_PLAN_VAL      I GET_WORKTIME                  Determination of Working Time from Planned Value            .
IF_EX_HRFPM_OUTPUT_HANDLER     I DISPLAY_RESULTS               Display Results of Commitment Run                           .
IF_EX_HRFPM_PREPARE_CIPE       I PREPARE_CIPE                  Call of Special Module before PBC Payroll Simulation        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_REOC               I GET_REOC_ACTIVE               Decision: Reassignment Lock Active for Position             .
IF_EX_HRFPM_ROLL1520           I ORIG_BUDGET_ROUND             Round Original Budget                                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_RULES_FILTER       I GET_FILTER_VALS               Derive Filter Values                                        .
IF_EX_HRFPM_VACANCY            I MAP_COSTS_WITH_VACANCY        Merging of Costs with Vacancy Periods                       .
IF_EX_HRFPM_WD_REPORTS         I CHANGE_REPORT_ATTRIBUTES      Change Report Attributes According to User                  .
IF_EX_HRGB_EXIT_ANSAL_FUNC     I EXIT_SAPLHRGPBS_PARA_001      Exit to Determine Number of Periods ( Feature 'PFREQ' )     .
IF_EX_HRGB_EXIT_ANSAL_FUNC     I EXIT_SAPLHRGPBS_PARA_002      Exit for Calculating Salary Percentage from IT0008          .
IF_EX_HRGB_EXIT_ANSAL_FUNC     I EXIT_SAPLHRGPBS_PARA_003      Exit for Calculating Salary Percentage from IT0014          .
IF_EX_HRGB_EXIT_ANSAL_FUNC     I EXIT_SAPLHRGPBS_PARA_004      Exit for Calculating Salary Percentage from IT0015          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ACC_HEADER       I GET_HEADER_ACCESS             Get Header Data Access                                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ACC_HEADER       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ACTION_LOG       I GET_ACTION_LOG                Get Action Log (Non-Standard Action Log)                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ACTION_LOG       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ACTION_LOG       I MODIFY_DETAILED_LOG           Change Detailed Action Log                                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADD_HEADER       I GET_ADD_HEADER_DATA           Get Additional Header Data                                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADD_HEADER       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Bring Data to Screen                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADD_HEADER       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Bring Data to Screen                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADD_ON_APPL      I GET_CATEGORY_RESTRICTION      Get Category Restriction                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADMIN            I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Administrator Functions               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADMIN            I REGISTRATION                  Register Administrator Functions                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ADMIN            I START_FUNCTION                Start Administrator Functions                               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ATT_ACCESS       I GET_ATTACHMENT_MODE           Determine Attachment Mode                                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ATT_ACCESS       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_AUTHORITY        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_AUTHORITY        I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEMENT       I BUSINESS_CHECK_VA             Business Check Template                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEMENT       I BUSINESS_CHECK_VB             Business Check Criteria Group                               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEMENT       I BUSINESS_CHECK_VC             Business Check Criterion                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEMENT       I BUSINESS_CHECK_VX             Business Check Foreign Element                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEM_DEL      I BUSINESS_CHECK_DEL_VA         Business Check Template Deletion                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEM_DEL      I BUSINESS_CHECK_DEL_VB         Business Check Criteria Group Deletion                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEM_DEL      I BUSINESS_CHECK_DEL_VC         Business Check Criterion Deletion                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BC_ELEM_DEL      I BUSINESS_CHECK_DEL_VX         Business Check  Foreign Element Deletion                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BSP_TMPL         I BSP_APPLICATION_GET           BSP: Get Alternative Customer Template                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BUT_ACCESS       I GET_BUTTON_ACCESS             Get Pushbutton Access                                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_BUT_ACCESS       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATALOG_ACT      I GET_ACTION_FOR_OK_CODE        Get Catalog Action from OK-Code Field                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATALOG_ACT      I GET_SCREEN_FOR_ACTION         Get Action Info for Context Menu Entry                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATALOG_ACT      I SET_CONTEXT_MENU_ENTRY        Set Context Menu Entry for Appraisal Catalog Entry          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATEG_CREATE     I CREATE_CATEGORY               Create Category                                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATEG_EXMPLE     I CREATE_CATEGORY               Create Template                                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATEG_EXMPLE     I GET_INFORMATION               Get Template Information                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CATEG_EXMPLE     I REGISTRATION                  Register Creation for Current Category                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_FURTHER_TABLES          Check Further Tables (Not Standard Appraisal Tables)        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_SYSTEM_AVAILABILITY     Check for Special System Availability                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T777E                   Check Special Relationships                                 .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T777I                   Check Specific Infotype Assignments                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T777Z                   Check Specific Time Constraint                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T778A                   Specific Evaluation Paths                                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T778A_SINGLE            Specific Evaluation Paths - Individual Check                .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T778O                   Check Specific External Element Types                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77HAP_COL              Check Specific Columns                                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77HAP_EX               Check Specific Enhancements                                 .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77HAP_EX_AREA          Check Specific Enhancement Areas                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77HAP_ROLE             Check Specific Roles                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77HAP_VAL_CLS          Check Specific Value Classes                                .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77MWBFCD               Check Function Codes for Manager's Desktop                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77MWBFCH               Check Higher-Level Function Codes for Manager's Desktop     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_CHECK_CUSTOM     I CHECK_T77S0                   Parameter Check T77S0                                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_COL_ACCESS       I GET_COLUMN_ACCESS             Get Column Access                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_COL_ACCESS       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_COL_OWNER        I CHECK_COLUMN_OWNER            Check Column Owner                                          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_COL_OWNER        I CUST_CHECK_SETTING            Customizing: Check Owner Setting (Infotype 5023)            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DEFAULT_OBJ      I GET_OBJECT_FOR_USER           User -" Object                                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DEFAULT_OBJ      I GET_USER_FOR_OBJECT           Object -" User                                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_BC           I DO_BUSINESS_CHECK             Perform Customer-Specific Business Checks                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_BC           I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_D1       I DEFAULT_APPRAISER             Default Appraiser                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_D1       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_D2       I DEFAULT_APPRAISEE             Default Appraisee                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_D2       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DE       I DEFAULT_EXECUTION_PERIOD      Default Execution Period                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DE       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DN       I DEFAULT_NAME                  Default Appraisal Document Name                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DN       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DO       I DEFAULT_OTHERS                Default Further Participants                                .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DO       I GET_INFORMATION               Information About Implementation                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DP       I DEFAULT_PART_APPRAISERS       Default Part Appraiser                                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DP       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DR       I DEFAULT_REVIEW_DATE           Default Review Date                                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DR       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DV       I DEFAULT_PERIOD                Default Appraisal Period                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DEF_DV       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DELETE       I DELETE_DOCUMENT               To Handle Own Data - Do Not COMMIT !!!                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_DELETE       I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_PREPARE      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Reporting Function                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_PREPARE      I PERFORM_PREPARATION           Execute Reporting                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_PREPARE      I REGISTRATION                  Register Reporting Function                                 .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_SAVE         I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_SAVE         I SAVE_DOCUMENT                 Save Appraisal Document                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DOC_STATNAME     I GET_STATUS_NAME               Read Status Name                                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DYN_EVENT        I ALLOW_MULTIPLE_REFERENCES     Allow Elements for Multiple References                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DYN_EVENT        I CUST_CHECK_ENHANCEMENT        Customizing Check: Enhancing Event?                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DYN_EVENT        I GET_DYNAMIC_EVENT             Dynamic Event                                               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DYN_EVENT        I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Dynamic Event                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_DYN_EVENT        I STAY_OR_GO                    Behavior During Status Change                               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_DEL      I CHECK_EXECUTABILITY           App. Document: Check the Executability of Deletion          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_DEL      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Delete                                .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FIX      I ALLOW_MULTIPLE_REFERENCES     Allow Elements for Multiple Reference                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FIX      I ENHANCE_DOCUMENT              Appraisal Document: Enhance Appraisal Document              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FIX      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Enhancement                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FREE     I ALLOW_MULTIPLE_REFERENCES     Allow Elements for Multiple Reference                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FREE     I CHECK_EXECUTABILITY           App. Document: Check Executability of Enhancement           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FREE     I ENHANCE_DOCUMENT              Appraisal Document: Enhance Appraisal Document              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_ENHANCE_FREE     I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Enhancement                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_FOLLOW_UP        I FOLLOW_UP                     Follow-Up Processing                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_FOLLOW_UP        I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Follow-Up Processing                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_FOLLOW_UP_D      I FOLLOW_UP                     Follow-Up Processing                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_FOLLOW_UP_D      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Follow-Up Processing                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_GET_LIST_FLT     I GET_LIST_XXL                  Use Filter Value for Lists                                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_INIT_CATALOG     I INIT_CATALOG                  Call Appraisal Catalog for Initialization                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_LINK             I GET_ICON                      Get Icon for Link                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_LINK             I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Link                                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_LINK             I SHOW_LINK                     Display Link (SAP R/3)                                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_LINK             I SHOW_LINK_GET_URL             Display Link (Web - Get URL)                                .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_LINK             I START_NEW_WINDOW              Start Link in New Window? (SAP R/3)                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_MAX_P_APPER      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Implementation                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_MAX_P_APPER      I GET_MAXIMUM_NUMBER            Get Maximum Number of Part Appraisers                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_OFFLINE          I DOWNLOAD                      Online Document: Download Data                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_OFFLINE          I GET_INFORMATION               Get Informaton About Offline Function                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_OFFLINE          I UPLOAD                        Offline Document: Read Data                                 .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_REPORTING        I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Reporting Function                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_REPORTING        I PERFORM_REPORTING             Execute Reporting                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_REPORTING        I REGISTRATION                  Register Reporting Function                                 .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_REP_GEN_VAR      I FIELD_VALUES_GET              Get Possible Generic Field Values                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_REP_GEN_VAR      I FILL_SELECTION_CRITERIA       Fill Selection Criteria for a Specific Generic Field Value  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_SELECTION        I GET_ALL_OBJECTS               Get All Objects with Current Role (for Base Object)         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_SELECTION        I GET_INFORMATION               Get Template Information                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_SMARTFORMS       I GET_OUTPUT_INFO_WITH_DATA     Get Output Format for Existing 'External' App. Document Data.
IF_EX_HRHAP00_SMARTFORMS       I PRINT_DOCUMENT                Print Appraisal Documents (Internal Read of App.Documents)  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_SMARTFORMS       I PRINT_WITH_DATA               Print Existing 'External' Appraisal Document Data           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TEXT_SUBST       I GET_TEXT_SUBSTITUTE           Text Replacement                                            .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TEXT_SUBST       I GET_TEXT_SUBST_DEFAULT        Default Text Replacement                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_608         I APPRAISEE_CHECK_ALLOWED       Check whether appraisee is allowed                          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_608         I APPRAISEE_GET_LIST            Read allowed appraisees                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_608         I APPRAISER_CHECK_ALLOWED       Check whether appraiser is allowed                          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_608         I APPRAISER_GET_LIST            Read allowed appraisers                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_608         I TEMPLATE_GET_LIST             Read allowed templates                                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_EXAMPLE     I CREATE_TEMPLATE               Create Template                                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_EXAMPLE     I GET_INFORMATION               Get Template Information                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_EXAMPLE     I REGISTRATION                  Register Creation for Current Category                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_GETLIST     I GET_LIST                      Get Template List                                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_WIZARD      I CREATE_TEMPLATE               Create Template                                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_WIZARD      I GET_INFORMATION               Get Template Information                                    .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_TMPL_WIZARD      I REGISTRATION                  Register Creation for Current Category                      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CHECK_DESCRIPTION_AVAILABILITYCheck Availability: Value Description                       .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Existence of Value List                               .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CHECK_VALUE_CLASS_NUMERIC     Check Whether Value Class Is Numeric or Non-Numeric         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CHECK_VALUE_TEXT_AVAILABILITY Check Availability: Value Text                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CHECK_VALUE_VALIDITY          Check Validity of a Value                                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CONVERT_VALUE_EID_TO_IID      Convert External to Internal ID (Numeric Value Classes)     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CONVERT_VALUE_IID_TO_EID      Convert Internal to External ID (Numeric Value Classes)     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I CREATE_VALUE_TYPE             Create Standard Value List (If Not Yet Created)             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I DO_MATCHUP                    Synchronize Value Lists with T77HAP_VALTY                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_DETAIL                    Get Detail for Value List                                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_LIST                      Get Value Lists                                             .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_MAX_VALUE                 Get Maximum Value (Numeric Value Classes)                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_MIN_VALUE                 Get Minimum Value (Numeric Value Class)                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_NEXT_VALID_VALUE          Get Next Valid Value (Numeric Value Class)                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_NUMBER_OF_DECIMALS        Get Number of Decimal Values (Numeric Value Class)          .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_NUMBER_OF_VALUES          Get Number of Values                                        .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_VALUE_DESCRIPTIONS        Get Value Descriptions (CHECK_DESCRIPTION_AVAILABILITY)     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VALUE_TYPE       I GET_VALUE_TEXT                Get Value Text                                              .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I CHECK_EXECUTABILITY           Check Whether Value Determination Is to Be Executed         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I CHECK_UI_DEPENDENCY           Check User Interface Dependency on Value Determination      .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I CUST_CHECK_EXECUTABILITY      Customizing Check: Can Value Determination Be Executed?     .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I CUST_COLUMN_RESTRICTION       Customizing: Restriction for Specific Colimns? (Input Help) .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I GET_INFORMATION               Get Information About Value Determination                   .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_VAL_DET          I VALUE_DETERMINATION           Value Determination                                         .
IF_EX_HRHAP00_WF_RULE_ID       I GET_ACTORS                    Get Actors                                                  .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I APPRAISEE_CHECK_ALLOWED       Check whether appraisee is allowed                          .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I APPRAISEE_GET_LIST            Read allowed appraisees                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I APPRAISER_CHECK_ALLOWED       Check whether appraiser is allowed                          .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I APPRAISER_GET_LIST            Read allowed appraisers                                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I OTHERS_CHECK_ALLOWED          Check whether further participants are allowed              .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I OTHERS_GET_LIST               Read allowed further participants                           .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I PART_APPRAISER_CHECK_ALLOWED  Check whether part appraiser is allowed                     .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I PART_APPRAISER_GET_LIST       Read allowed part appraisers                                .
IF_EX_HRHAP_RESTRICT_DATA      I TEMPLATE_GET_LIST             Read allowed templates                                      .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DC_COSTITEMS     I CHANGE_DATASETS               Change Cost Item Data Records                               .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DC_EMPLOYEE      I GET_DATA                      Return Cost Items for Each Employee                         .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DC_ORGOBJECT     I GET_DATA                      Return Cost Items for Each Organizational Object            .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DERIVE_VALU      I CHANGE_DERIVED_COSTITEMS      Change Derived Cost Items                                   .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DERIVE_VALU      I GET_ORG_GROUPING_EMPLOYEE     Determine Organizational Grouping for Employees             .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DERIVE_VALU      I GET_ORG_GROUPING_ORGOBJECT    Determine Organizational Grouping for Organizational Objects.
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DET_UI           I COSTOBJECT_INFO               Information on Cost Object                                  .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_DET_UI           I GET_INFO_BUTTON_TEXT          Determine Text for Information Button                       .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_POST_PERIODS     I CHANGE_POSTING_PERIODS        Change Posting Periods                                      .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RESP_OBJECTS     I CHECK_COSTPLANNER_AUTHORITY   Check Authorization as Person Responsible for Cost Planning .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RESP_OBJECTS     I GET_RESPONSIBLE_CO_OBJECTS    Determine Acc. Assignment Objects in Area of Responsibility .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RESP_OBJECTS     I GET_RESPONSIBLE_ORGUNITS      Determine Org. Units in Area of Responsibility              .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RESP_OBJECTS     I GET_VALID_ACTIONS             Determine Allowed Actions                                   .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RESP_OBJECTS     I GET_VALID_HEADCOUNT_JOBS      Determine Allowed Jobs for Quota Planning                   .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RUN_HEADC        I GET_HEADCOUNT_OBJECTS         Provide Quota Planning Objects                              .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RUN_OBJSEL       I CHANGE_OTHER_OBJECTS          Change Selection for Other Objects                          .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_RUN_OBJSEL       I CHANGE_POSITIONS_AND_EMPLOYEESChange Selection for Positions and Employees                .
IF_EX_HRHCP00_TIMESPLITS       I CONVERT_PERIODS               Convert Periods                                             .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_REG_SC_INFO              Read registration program of study information              .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_REG_SM_INFO              Read registration module information                        .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_SC_INFO                  Read program of study information                           .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_SC_TEXT                  Read texts of program information                           .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_SM_INFO                  Read module information                                     .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_SM_TEXT                  Read texts of module information                            .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_ST_INFO                  Read student information                                    .
IF_EX_HRIQ_BADI_READ           I READ_ST_TEXT                  Read texts of student information                           .
IF_EX_HRIQ_CORR_FORMKEY        I GET_FORMKEY                   Get Application Form                                        .
IF_EX_HRIV_REDUCE_AMOUNT       I DO_REDUCTION                  Perform Reduction                                           .
IF_EX_HRLDAP_ATTRIBUTES        I GET_RDN                       Return RDN for a Person                                     .
IF_EX_HRLDAP_ATTRIBUTES        I GET_SAP_WP_USER               Return Workplace User Name                                  .
IF_EX_HRMGE00CPICALC0001       I CALCULATE_VALUE               Calculate Value for the requested derived CPI               .
IF_EX_HRMGE00CPICALC0002       I CALCULATE_VALUE               Calculate Value for the requested Base CPI                  .
IF_EX_HRMGE00CPICALC0002       I DETERMINE_CALCULATION_CPI     Determine CPIs needed for the calculation of the current CPI.
IF_EX_HRMGE00CURRCONVDATE      I DETERMINE_CONV_DATE           Determines the Currency Conversion Date                     .
IF_EX_HRMGE00INTLADMIN         I ADMINISTRATOR_GROUP           Get responsible Administrator group                         .
IF_EX_HRMGE00OFFERSHEET        I EXPORT_WORD_DATA              Export Master Data to Word                                  .
IF_EX_HRMGE00OFFERSHEET        I MASTERDATA                    Modify master data                                          .
IF_EX_HRMGE00REGION            I DETERMINE_REGION              Determine region                                            .
IF_EX_HROM_EXP_PATH            I CHANGE_EXP_PATH               Add/Remove Maintainable Relationships                       .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I ADD_NAVIGATION_STEP           Note Navigation for Undo                                    .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I ADD_UNDO_STEP                 Note Undo Step                                              .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I GET_BUFFER_CHANGE_STATE       Sets Flag if Buffer has Changed Since Last Access           .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I GET_CHANGED_FLAG              Read Change Flag                                            .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I GET_UNDO_REDO_STATUS          Is Undo/Redo Active?                                        .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Buffer                                           .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I REDO                          One Step Forwards (Redo)                                    .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I UNDO                          One Step Back (Undo)                                        .
IF_EX_HROM_NF_BUFFER           I WRITE_BUFFER_TO_DB            Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MAX_INFTY_AUTHORIZATION Maximum Check for Infotype Authorization                    .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MAX_LEVEL_AUTHORIZATION Maximum Check for Authorization Level                       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MAX_PERNR_AUTHORIZATION Maximum Check for Personnel Number Authorization            .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MAX_SUBTY_AUTHORIZATION Maximum Check for Subtype Authorization                     .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MIN_INFTY_AUTHORIZATION Minimum Check for Infotype Authorization                    .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MIN_LEVEL_AUTHORIZATION Minimum Check for Authorization Level                       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MIN_PERNR_AUTHORIZATION Minimum Check for Personnel Number Authorization            .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_MIN_SUBTY_AUTHORIZATION Minimum Check for Subtype Authorization                     .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I CHECK_PERNR_AUTHORIZATION     Check for Personnel Number Authorization                    .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I DELAYED_CONSTRUCTOR           Substitute for CONTRUCTOR                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I SET_ORG_ASSIGNMENT            Set Organizational Assignment                               .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_CHECK        I SET_PARTIAL_ORG_ASSIGNMENT    Partially Set Organizational Assignemnt (example: Settings) .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_RECORD       I RECORD_AUTH_RESULTS           Record Authorization                                        .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_TIME         I BEGDA_ENDDA_COMPARE_EXIT      Compare with the Validity Date of the Infotype Record       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00AUTH_TIME         I CONSIDER_SY_DATUM_EXIT        Time Logic in the PA Authorization Check                    .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTY             I AFTER_INPUT                   Infotype Maintenance: Call-Up Time PAI                      .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTY             I BEFORE_OUTPUT                 Infotype Maintenance: Call-Up Time PBO                      .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTY             I IN_UPDATE                     Update Program: Call-Up During Update                       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I DELETE_COMPUTATIONS           Infotype-Specific Logic for Delete                          .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I INITIAL_COMPUTATIONS          Infotype-Specific Processing of Record Creation             .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I INSERT_COMPUTATIONS           Infotype-Specific Logic for Insert                          .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I METADATA_COMPUTATIONS         Process Data According to Metadata                          .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I MODIFY_COMPUTATIONS           Infotype-Specific Logic for Modify                          .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYBL           I READ_COMPUTATIONS             Infotype-Specific Single Record Processing After Read       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYUI           I FILL_HELP_VALUES              Fill Value Help                                             .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYUI           I INPUT_CONVERSION              Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Structure        .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYUI           I INPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION        Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Repeat Structure .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYUI           I OUTPUT_CONVERSION             Conversion of Infotype Structure to Screen Structure        .
IF_EX_HRPAD00INFTYUI           I OUTPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION       Conversion of Infotype Repeat Structure to Screen Structure .
IF_EX_HRPAD00MGEACTIVATION     I CALL_ACTIVATION               Call Activation Method                                      .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_ADRS             I MODIFY_ADDRESS                Change Contents of Address Structure                        .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_ENTRY_LEAVE      I GET_ENTRY_DATE                Determine Entry Date                                        .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_ENTRY_LEAVE      I GET_LEAVING_DATE              Determine Leaving Date                                      .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_GET_AF_0008      I GET_FIELD_VALUE               Calculation/Valuation of Additional Field                   .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_PAPM             I GET_SHLPS                     Assignment of Elementary Search Helps                       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_PREM             I GET_SHLPS                     Assignment of Elementary Search Helps                       .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_RECOG_SCREEN     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport Data from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAD00_RECOG_SCREEN     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data to Screen                                    .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_FED_LOW          I GET_FED_LOW_DISPLAY           Determine whether Federal Letters of Waiver are displayed   .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PB07_0001        I GET_BUSINESS_NUMBER           Determine New Business Number After Merger/Acquisition      .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PB07_0001        I GET_QCTX_ID                   Determine New Quebec Tax ID After Merger/Acquisition        .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PC07_0001        I GET_REGISTRATION_NUMBER       Get Business Number                                         .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PC07_0002        I GET_ACCOUNT_NUMBER            Get Account Number                                          .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PC07_0004        I FILL_TAX_FRAMEWORK            Fill tax framework with additional field values             .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_PROV_LOW         I GET_PROV_LOW_DISPLAY          Determine whether Provincial Letters of Waiver are displayed.
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_001     I CHANGE_EEA_BUFFER             Change values in EEA buffer                                 .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_001     I EXPORT_EECRS_FILES            Export EECRS files created by EEA report                    .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_001     I GET_CONTRACT_PERIODS          Get Contract Periods for Temporary Employee                 .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_001     I GET_EEA_SALARY                Get EEA Salary                                              .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_001     I GET_EMPLOYEE_CONTRACT         Determine if employee is full-time, part-time or Temporary  .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPLEEAK0_002     I GET_WEEKS_WORKED              Get number of weeks worked by temp EE                       .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPUTXUK0_001     I GET_EFFECTIVE_DATE            Get new tax year's effective date                           .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPUTXUK0_001     I GET_NEW_FEDERAL_TAX_CREDITS   Get new personal tax credits for federal taxes              .
IF_EX_HRPADCA_RPUTXUK0_001     I GET_NEW_PROVINCIAL_TAX_CREDITSGet new personal tax credits for provincial taxes           .
IF_EX_HRPADIT_730              I CHECK_IF_CID_TO_PROCESS       Check whether Personnel Number is correct and load data     .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_0290             I CHECK_BIRTHPLACE              Subty 802 - Check Birthplace Data                           .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_P4               I CHECK_MASS_REDUCTION          Checks for mass reduction                                   .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_P4               I CHECK_OWN_WISH_LEAVE          Check for leaving on own wish                               .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_P4               I CHECK_PART_3                  Checks for permissibility in part 3 of                      .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_P4               I CHECK_REDUCTION               Check for reduction                                         .
IF_EX_HRPADRU_P4               I SET_HIRE_FIRE_CRITERIA        Set hire and fire criteria                                  .
IF_EX_HRPADUS_OSHA_0001        I MODIFY_OSHA_INFO              Modify Injury/illness information for an employee           .
IF_EX_HRPADUS_PBAS_0001        I GET_MSG_TYPE_TEXT             Message type and message text                               .
IF_EX_HRPAD_SUBTY_CHECK        I CHECK_SUBTY                   Eligibility SUBTY for INFTY                                 .
IF_EX_HRPAD_SUBTY_CHECK        I CHECK_SUBTY_BY_MOLGA          Eligibility for MOLGA / INFTY                               .
IF_EX_HRPAD_SUBTY_CHECK        I CHECK_SUBTY_BY_PERNR          Eligibility for PERNR / INFTY                               .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_COL_DME          I ADAPT_PURPOSE                 Adjusting the Purpose                                       .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_COL_DME_KEYS     I ADDITIONAL_KEYS               Division of Transfers According to Additional Criteria      .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_COL_DME_KEYS     I KEEP_BT_FIELDS                Division of Transfers According to Additional BT Fields     .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_ESS_PAYSLIP      I CHECK_IF_ESS_PAYSLIP          Check if remuneration statement is only accessible using ESS.
IF_EX_HRPAY00_ESS_PAYSLIP      I SET_INFTY_READ_DATE           Set Read Date for Infotype 0655                             .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_EXP_COPL         I PROCESS_DATA                  Further Process Data from Payroll Posting                   .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PAYMENTS         I CHANGE_PAYMENT_DATA           Adjusting the Filled REGUH and REGUP Entries                .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I CHECK_DELETION_SUPPORTED      Does the run type support the deletion of a run?            .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I CHECK_DETAILINFO_SUPPORTED    Is the display of detail information supported? + rep. name .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I CHECK_PCP0_SUPPORTED          Does the run type use the display of transaction PCP0?      .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I CHECK_REVERSAL_SUPPORTED      Does the run type support the cancellation of runs?         .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I CHECK_SPECIALPERIODS_SUPPORTEDDoes the Run Type Support Postings to Special Periods?      .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I DELETE_RUN                    Delete run / also delete application data                   .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I DETERMINE_RUN_INFO            Determine run information using run attributes              .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I DISPLAY_DETAILED_INFO         Display detail information for document line items          .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I POST_RUN                      Post run and update application data                        .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I REORG_RUN                     Cancel run and delete application data                      .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PCP0             I REVERSE_RUN                   Cancel run and delete application data                      .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PRE_DME          I ADAPT_REMUN_STATEMENT         Reprocessing of the Salary Statement in the Purpose         .
IF_EX_HRPAY00_PRE_DME          I ADDITIONAL_WAGETYPES          Additional Wage Types from Retroactive Accounting Results   .
IF_EX_HRPAY99_KTO              I CHANGE_RGDIR_NATIO            Re-builds rgdir depending on the requirements of a country  .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_ANSTA                  Adjust the employee's Employment Status (ANSTA)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_BEMOD                  To override the standard BEMOD determination                .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_CARENCE_SUPPRESSION    adjust the suppression of the carence day                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_DAYTYPE                adjust the definition of public holiday,working day, day off.
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_GET_SEQNR_AFTER_COLLIS exit to set the counting of days after a collision ends     .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_HALF_DAY_COLLIDER      Trim processing for collisions of half day absences         .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_PROBATORY_SINGLE_INIT  adjust the probationary period begin and end dates          .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_PROLONGATION_CHECK     adjust the determination of the prolongation for special cas.
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_PUBLIC_HOLIDAY_MARK    Adjust the marking for the public holiday overriding BPUHO  .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_PUB_HOLIDAY_SENIORITY  Adjust the marking for public holidays in seniority periods .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_REMOVE_CARENCE_DAY     adjust the removal of the carnece day in case of collisions .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_ABSENCES         I ADJUST_SEQNR_INIT             Exit for the initialisation days counting (for collisions)  .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_BFIRE_DAYS       I ADJUST_NUMBER_DAYS            Change num of days where allowance is distributed           .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAOC           I USER_HIRE_FIRE                Deternine hire-fire dates                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAUP04         I GET_STATKEY_EE                Get data from key                                           .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAWR01         I CHECK_REFERENCE               Check Reference                                             .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAWR02         I DOWNLOAD                      Download                                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAWR02         I SENDER                        Sender                                                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFAWR02         I UPLOAD                        Upload                                                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_FIRE        I ADJUST_OCCU_LINE              For Occu of fired pernr, adjust time fields as required     .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_FIRE        I ADJUST_SERVICE_LINE           For Service of fired pernr, adjust fields as required       .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_JUSTIF      I GET_WORKED_DAYS               Gets the number of worked days relevant for justification   .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_LIM         I LIMIT_DEDUCTIONS              Limits SI deductions to the SI contributions                .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_USERREF     I GET_NATP_USER_REFERENCE       Gets the natural person user reference                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_USERREF     I GET_OCCU_USER_REFERENCE       Gets the occupation line user reference                     .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_USERREF     I GET_WREC_USER_REFERENCE       Gets the worker record user reference                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DMFA_WDS         I COMPUTE_WDS                   Compute field 47 for DMFA                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_DTA01            I OVERWRITE_LZBKZ               Overwrite field lzbkz (State central bank indicator)        .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_GARNISH01        I GET_DEPENDANT_CHILDREN        Fetches the number of children relevant for Garnishments    .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_MWHWK            I GET_MEAN_WORK_HOURS           modify mean working hours in payroll                        .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_PAYROLL          I GET_LATEST_RETRODATE          Gets  latest acceptable retrocalculation date-see feat BECOT.
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_SRD_PUHOL        I GET_PUHOL_REPLACEMENTS        Get Public holiday replacements                             .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_TAXBSE_HOLID     I GET_VARIABLE_TAXBASE          modify the date of legal change vac_tax_base_452            .
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_TAX_NEG          I GET_NEGATIVE_STATUS           Decides if a negatv amount is low enough to consider it nill.
IF_EX_HRPAYBE_TAX_OVRTIME      I GET_DETAIL_OVERTIME           Gets the overtime reduction/base, calculated in detail      .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_CFER_PAYDATE     I DEFINE_PAYDATE                Defines vacation payment date                               .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_CFER_PAYROLL     I BATCH_PROCESS                 Desired processing before batch execution of payroll        .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_CFER_PAYROLL     I ONLINE_PROCESS                Desired processing before online execution of payroll       .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_FCOL_PAYDATE     I DEFINE_PAYDATE                Sets payment date of company vacation                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_FCOL_PAYROLL     I BATCH_PROCESS                 Desired processing before batch execution of payroll        .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_FCOL_PAYROLL     I ONLINE_PROCESS                Desired processing before online execution of payroll       .
IF_EX_HRPAYBR_RAIS_RECORD1     I UPDATE_RECORD1                Maintain fields of record type 1                            .
IF_EX_HRPAYCA_ROE_001          I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check authority of user to view employee data               .
IF_EX_HRPAYCA_ROE_001          I FILL_ROE_DATA                 Fill ROE data                                               .
IF_EX_HRPAYCA_ROE_002          I CHECK_ROEWB_STATUS            Determine Status of ROE Workbench.                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYCA_RP_ROE           I SAP_SCRIPT_TABLES             Export/import SAPSCRIPT tables                              .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHBGAC0             I CHANGE_BSGR                   Change capacity utilization                                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHERC0              I GET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Determine Default Values for the Infotype 0600              .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHERC0              I GET_OUTPUT_STRUCTURE          Determine Output Structure                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHLAW0              I GET_SPLIT_INDICATOR           Determine Split Indicator for Wage Statement                .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHLAW2              I CHANGE_OUTPUT                 Output structure                                            .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHLAW2              I CHANGE_SPLIT_INTERVALS        Determine Time Intervals                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHLAW2B             I GET_PARTTIME                  Override Comments on Part-Time Work                         .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHLVG0              I GET_PERNR                     Processing with Event "GET PERS. NO."                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHRMC0              I GET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Determine Default Values for Infotype 0977                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYCHRMC0              I GET_OUTPUT_STRUCTURE          Determine Output Structure                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_AAI2             I MODIFY_DECLARATION            Modify the data of the declaration                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_ADP_BACKUP       I BACKING_UP_TEDM               Saved copy of TEDM tables                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_ADP_PERNUM       I CHECK_PAYROLL_RESULTS         Payroll results check                                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_ADP_TEDM         I TEDM_EXTENSION                TEDM File Extension Management                              .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_ADP_TRANSP       I MODIFY_OBJECT_LIST            Change Objects List                                         .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_ADP_VALUE        I GET_VARIABLE_VALUES           Determine Value of a Scenario Variable                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_CRC              I GET_CENTRE_PAYEUR             Payer search                                                .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_CRC              I GET_GROUPE_COTISANT           Contributor search                                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I FILL_STRUCTURE_PMEF2          Fill in the specific fields (PS) of structure pmef2         .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I GET_S41_END_REASON_CODE       Determine the end reason code of the activity period        .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I GET_S41_START_REASON_CODE     Determine the start reason code of the activity period      .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_EMETTEUR              Process the sender structure (structure 10)                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ENTREP                Process the company structure (structure 20)                .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ETAB                  Process the place of work structure (structure 80)          .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_HONORAIRE             Process the withholding tax structure (structure 70)        .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_SALARIE               Process the employee structures (structures 30, 41 and 46)  .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_SITUATION             Process the situation structure (structure 41)              .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ST41                  Modify/create structures 41 (dates and records)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ST42_ST43_ST53        Process structures 42, 43, 53 (IRCANTEC, CNRACL, RAFP)      .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ST46                  Modify/create structures 46 (dates and records)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_ST51                  Modify/create structures 51                                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_TAB_RESULT            Filtering of sent table                                     .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I PROCESS_TOTAL_ENVOI           Modify the sent total structure (structure 90)              .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU            I READ_SPECIFIC_INFOTYPES       Reads specific infotypes                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I GET_S41_END_REASON_CODE       Determine the end reason code of the activity period        .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I GET_S41_START_REASON_CODE     Determine the start reason code of the activity period      .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_EMETTEUR              Process the sender structure (structure 10)                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ENTREP                Process the company structure (structure 20)                .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ETAB                  Process the place of work structure (structure 80)          .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_HONORAIRE             Process the withholding tax structure (structure 70)        .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_SALARIE               Process the employee structures (structures 30, 41 and 46)  .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_SITUATION             Process the situation structure (structure 41)              .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ST41                  Modify/create structures 41 (dates and records)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ST42_ST43_ST53        Process structures 42, 43, 53 (IRCANTEC, CNRACL, RAFP)      .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ST46                  Modify/create structures 46 (dates and records)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_ST51                  Modify/create structures 51                                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_TAB_RESULT            Filtering of sent table                                     .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I PROCESS_TOTAL_ENVOI           Modify the sent total structure (structure 90)              .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I READ_SPECIFIC_INFOTYPES       Reads specific infotypes                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DADSU_CUST       I SELECT_EE_PAYS_BY_FRACTION    Select. employee payroll results if splitting               .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DUCS             I PROCESS_BRC_AFTER_EXTDATA     Modification of the BRC after modif. performed of ext. file .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_DUCS             I PROCESS_BRC_BEFORE_OUTPUT     Modification of the results table before layout             .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_FCCO             I ADJUST_CONTRIBUTIONS          Final calculation of contributions                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_FSPEC            I DEFINE_MODEXO2                Define the second modificator MODEXO2 for searching in T5F1K.
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_FSPEC            I ENRICH_WAGE_TYPES             Enrich the wage types for special contracts                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_PART_TIME        I IS_PART_TIME                  Is it part time ?                                           .
IF_EX_HRPAYFR_QUALIF           I GET_QUALIF                    Qualification search                                        .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT51                I CALCULATE_DEDUCTIONS          Calculate deduction and P factor                            .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_CALC             I IDEDU_MENS_NTA_ADJUST         Adjustment of monthly deductions (no tax area) and p factor .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I COND_MESEPREC                 Previous month condition                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_ADJUST_DAY          Update daily calculation: weeks+differences                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_ADJUST_DAY_INAB     Change daily data for INAB                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_ADJUST_DAY_XNAB     Change daily data for XNAB                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_ADJUST_PERC_INAB    Change company/INPS percentage                              .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_ADJUST_WEEK         Update INPS week: weeks+differences                         .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_INPSM            I SETTIMANE_BEGDA_ENDDA         Adjust begda and edda for weeks valuation                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_OPRDTAB          I FILL_CUSTOM_ARG               Fill the custom argument for the generic table reader       .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR               I GET_XML                       Get XML for writing                                         .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR               I ROUND                         Exit for roundings                                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR_DAQ           I SET_DAQ_CONFIG                Set/change DAQ parameters                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR_DAQ           I SET_DAQ_INFOTYPES             Set here daq infotypes with set_infotype_table method       .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR_DAQ_CL        I SET_DAQ_CONFIG                Set/change DAQ parameters                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_UR_DAQ_CL        I SET_DAQ_INFOTYPES             Set here daq infotypes with set_infotype_table method       .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_DAYAB_DAYEV            dayab/dayev adjustment                                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_DAY_FRACTION           Marking adjustment                                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_DETERMINED_MARKS       Marking adjustment                                          .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_ITASS_VOSE_EFE         Exit during 'holiday' weekly wage type generation           .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_ITASS_VOSE_ENP         Exit during the 'unpr. event' weekly wage type generation   .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_MARK_MAPPING           ncale/cover mapping adjustment                              .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_SENIORITY_CALCULATION  Seniority adjustment                                        .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_SUBRU                  Exit for SUBRU field change                                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_SUBRU_T5ITI9           Exit for SUBRU field change for t5iti9                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_VALUATION_BASES        Valuation basis adjustment                                  .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I ADJUST_WAGES_IN_ITASSRICA     Exit for ind./int. wage type change in ITASS RICA           .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I DAYEV_FILTER_MARKTAB          Marktab filter for dayab/dayev adjustment                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYIT_XNAB             I RICA_FILTER_MARKTAB           Marktab filter for adjustment in ITASS RICA                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYMY_EAFORM           I GET_POSEAFORM                 Get Position Text for EA Form                               .
IF_EX_HRPAYNA_CCR_0001         I CHECK_AUTHORIZATIONS          Check for relevant authorizations                           .
IF_EX_HRPAYPT_ABSENCE_PER      I GET_CATS_ABSENCE_PER_INTERVAL Generates intervals in CATS absences                        .
IF_EX_HRPAYPT_ABSENCE_PER      I GET_CATS_ABSENCE_PER_INTER_LS Generates intervals in CATS abs.- for leave annual summary  .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_293              I GET_RAYROLL_DRIVER            Get payroll driver, subschema & HR form                     .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_AVERA_RELEV      I GET_MASTER_AVRULE             Get master AVRULE for relevancy tests                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_AVP0             I PROCESS_T_WAGE                Processing of wages table                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_AVP3             I PROCESS_T_WAGE                Processing of wages table                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_MINIMUM_NET      I DETERMINE_MIN_NET             Process and return minimum net amount                       .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_NDFL             I CHECK_FIELD_FILLING           Check necessity of field filling (p.3)                      .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_NDFL             I NDFL2_PROCESS_PY_RESULT       Postprocessing PY results before outputting                 .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_ODN              I FILL_REGUH                    Fill filelds for reguh (regup)                              .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_RUSI0            I GET_TIMES                     Prepare table with the times (PSP_AB, RTE_DIVI)             .
IF_EX_HRPAYRU_TAX_APKEY        I GET_APKEY                     Get additional key for tax schema assignment in T7RUP0      .
IF_EX_HRPAYSG_LABOURSURVEY     I JOB_VACANCIES                 Returns the vacancy count                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAYTH_TAXFORM          I CHANGE_ADDRESS                Method to change address                                    .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_EXCEP        I CRT_EXCEP                     ME exit for exceptions in CRT                               .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I CNIC_EXIT01                   CE exit for adjustment of CNIC after core CNIC              .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I COMPS_EXIT01                  CE exit for COMPS minimum payment check                     .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I NICALC_EXIT01                 CE exit for filling and sorting NICALC before core NI calc. .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I NICALC_EXIT02                 CE exit for filling and sorting NICALC after core NI calc.  .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I NIPAY_EXIT01                  CE exit for Niable pay calcualtion                          .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I NIRA_EXIT01                   CE exit for adjusting NI contribs/arrears                   .
IF_EX_HRPAY_GB_ME_NI           I POSTING_EXIT01                CE exit for posting of NI                                   .
IF_EX_HRPAY_US_TF_0001         I SET_VALUES                    Initialize parameters and call all other methods            .
IF_EX_HRPA_SHARING_REPOR       I READ_REPAIR_ORDER             Define Repair Sequence                                      .
IF_EX_HRPBS00I0716             I AFTER_INPUT                   Infotype Maintenance: Call-Up Time PAI                      .
IF_EX_HRPBS00I0716             I BEFORE_OUTPUT                 Infotype Maintenance: Call-Up Time PBO                      .
IF_EX_HRPBS00PWE               I SET_DEFAULT_PROCSCEN          Set the inital process scenario for transaction             .
IF_EX_HRPBS06_AVG_ORGUNITS     I FILL_ORG_UNITS                Valuate resp. structural units & next (P06P1_AVGL)          .
IF_EX_HRPBS06_AVG_ORGUNITS     I GET_PLAN_VARIANT              Get Scheduling Variant for Texts of Organizational Units    .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_DRL_EXIT         I EDIT_OUTPUT                   Edit output data before passsing it to the ALV              .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_NISR        I CONTRACT                      Called after generation of Contract table record            .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_NISR        I PERSON                        Called after generation of Person table record              .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_STAFF       I CONTRACT                      Called after processing of contract; once per record        .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_STAFF       I CONVERSION                    Called after conversion, once per record written            .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_STAFF       I END                           Called for all records at once at the end before conversion .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_HESA_STAFF       I PERSON                        Called after processing of person, before contract          .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_REDUNDANCY       I PAYMENT                       Calculate redundany amount                                  .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_TPS              I ADDITION                      Called after processing of addition record for a person     .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_TPS              I AMENDMENT                     Called after processing of amendment record for a person    .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_TPS              I APPOINTMENT                   Called after processing of appointment record for a person  .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_TPS              I HEADER                        Called after processing of header for a person              .
IF_EX_HRPBSGB_TPS              I SERVICE                       Called after processing of service record for a person      .
IF_EX_HRPBSMX001               I CAL_INFTY_SALARY              Calculate salary from infotype                              .
IF_EX_HRPBSMX002               I GET_CHARGE_CODE               get value for charge code field in ISSSTE action file       .
IF_EX_HRPBSMX003               I GET_WORK_CENTER_CODE          Get work center code for SAR report                         .
IF_EX_HRPBSMX004               I GET_ISSSTE_STARTDATE          Get ISSSTE contribution start date                          .
IF_EX_HRPBSMX005               I GET_ICEFA                     Get  bank's code ICEFA.                                     .
IF_EX_HRPBSNOINDVAL            I INDIRECT_VALUATION            Indirect Valuation Module                                   .
IF_EX_HRPBSUS0001              I UPDATE_SPT_STATUS             Modify spt date and status after process                    .
IF_EX_HRPBSUSAD01              I CHECK_EMPLOYEE_FULL_TIME      Check whether an employee works full-time                   .
IF_EX_HRPBSUSREFORMAT          I REFORMAT_FIELD                Overwrite formatting and field text for field               .
IF_EX_HRPBSUSTC01              I GET_REQUIRED_AREAS            Get required certified areas                                .
IF_EX_HRPBSUSTC02              I CHECK_OUT_OF_FIELD            Check if it's out of field                                  .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0000     I APPRAISAL_CATALOG             Appraisal Catalog                                           .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0000     I APPRAISAL_RHP6                Appraisals in Profile                                       .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0000     I APPRAISAL_SEARCH              Find Appraisals                                             .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0000     I APPRAISAL_SHOW                Display Appraisal                                           .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0001     I SET_APPRAISAL_DATE            Default Period for Creating an Appraisal                    .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0002     I DELETE_APPRAISAL              Delete Analysis                                             .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0003     I CHECK_APPRAISAL_DATA          Check Appraisal Data                                        .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0004     I FILL_APPRAISAL_TABLES         Filling in the appraisal tables                             .
IF_EX_HRPDV00APPRAISAL0005     I CHECK_AUTH_TABLE              Perform Additional Checks                                   .
IF_EX_HRPDV00PROFILE0001       I CHECK_AUTHORITY_PARTPROFILE   Authorization Check for Accessing a Subprofile              .
IF_EX_HRPDV00PROFILE0002       I SORT_SKILLS_PROFILE           Sort Skills Profile                                         .
IF_EX_HRPDV00QSEARCH0001       I ADDITIONAL_SELECT_FOR_QSEARCH Additional Selection Options for "Find Objs. for Quals."    .
IF_EX_HRPDV00QUALI0001         I TRANSFER_QUALI                Transfer qualifications                                     .
IF_EX_HRPDV00QUALI0002         I MAINTAIN_DISPLAY_CATALOGUE    Display or Maintenance Mode for Qualifications Catalog      .
IF_EX_HRPDV00QUALI0003         I DELETE_CUT_QUALI              Qualification Deletion or Delimitiation                     .
IF_EX_HRPDV00QUALI0004         I WHERE_USED_QUALIFICATION      Check for Objects Related with Qualifications               .
IF_EX_HRPDV00TCS0001           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data for Person for SAP-Defined Subcategory   .
IF_EX_HRPDV00TCS0002           I TCS_DATA_READ                 Determine TCS Data of Person for Customer-Defined Subcat.   .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_CHECK_PLAN_LINE           Names of Function Module HR_PF_CHECK_PLAN_LINE_nn           .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_CONTROL_RECORD            Determine Control Data for a Pension Fund                   .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_IF_INIT                   Names of Function Module HR_PF_IF_INIT_nn                   .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_OLREP                     Names of Function Module HR_PF_OLREP_nn                     .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_OLREP_ALV                 Names of Function Module HR_PF_OLREP_ALV_nn                 .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_SHOW_VALUELIST            Names of Function Module HR_PF_SHOW_VALUELIST_nn            .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_UNIVERSAL_EVALUATION      Names of Universal Evaluation                               .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_VS_ERRORHANDLER           Names of Function Module HR_PF_VS_ERRORHANDLER_nn           .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_VS_INTERP_INIT            Names of Function Module HR_PF_VS_INTERP_INIT_nn            .
IF_EX_HRPFD00CTRL              I GET_VS_PERFORM                Names of Function Module HR_PF_VS_PERFORM_nn                .
IF_EX_HRPFD00FIIF              I FILL_ITEM                     Fill Document Line Item                                     .
IF_EX_HRPFD00FIIF              I GET_MATCHCODE                 Specify Matchcode to Determine Customer                     .
IF_EX_HRPFD00FIIF              I GET_SGTXT                     Fill Line Item Text                                         .
IF_EX_HRPFD00FIIF              I GET_SYMBOLIC_ACCOUNT          Determine Symbolic Account                                  .
IF_EX_HRPFD00PACA              I DISABLE_FUNCTION_VIEW         Deactivate Function View                                    .
IF_EX_HRPFD00PACA              I MODIFY_FUNCTION_VIEW          Modify Function View                                        .
IF_EX_HRPFD00PAYR              I FILL_IT                       Fill IT                                                     .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I GET_ACCT                      Get Account Data                                            .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I GET_MAST                      Get Master Data                                             .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I GET_PARM                      Get Parameters                                              .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I GET_PAYR                      Get Payroll Data                                            .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I GET_PERNR                     Read Personnel Number                                       .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I INIT_PERNR                    Initialization of a Personnel Number                        .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I READ_ACCT                     Read Account Data                                           .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I READ_MAST                     Read Master Data                                            .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I READ_PARM                     Read Parameters                                             .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I READ_PAYR                     Read Payroll Data                                           .
IF_EX_HRPFD00TESC              I SET_FCODE                     Sets OK Code of Main Screen for PAI Modules                 .
IF_EX_HRPFD00UNIV              I ADJUST_ALV                    Adjust Field Catalog and Layout for ALV Output              .
IF_EX_HRPFD00UNIV              I CHECK_SCHEM_OUTSQ             Check Schema and Output Sequence(s)                         .
IF_EX_HRPFD00UNIV              I FILL_FUND_LINE                Fill Additional Output Fields for Fund Evaluation           .
IF_EX_HRPFD00UNIV              I GET_PERNR                     Call per Processed Personnel Number                         .
IF_EX_HRPFD12VSIP              I EXECUTE_OPERATION             Execute Customer Specific Operation                         .
IF_EX_HRPH_CUSTOMER_SCHEMA     I GET_SCHEMA                    Method to allow customized SCHEMA                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00ADDOBJDETAILS     I READ_ADDITIONAL_DATA          Detailed Info on Object Set, Filter, and Sort Sequence      .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_APPOBJTXT     I GET_APPOBJTXT_COLUMN_TITLE    Get Column Headers                                          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_APPOBJTXT     I GET_APPOBJ_DESCRIPTION        Get Table Content Description                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_COMAPPOBJ     I MAP_APPSER_AGRTYPE            Assign Appraisal Type to Appraiser                          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_COMPPOBJ      I CHECK_EPACK_IS_APPOBJ         Check if SE is Relevant for Appraisal                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_EPACK         I CHECK_EPACK_IS_APPOBJ         Check if Event Package is Relevant for Appraisal            .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AGR_US_APPSER     I GET_APPRAISER_FROM_USER       Determine Appraiser from User                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUDTMPL_STATT     I AUDTMPL_STATTR_FILTER         Check Student Attributes                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUDTMPL_STATTR_FI I AUDTMPL_STATTR_FILTER         Determine if Template Should be Used                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUD_CATASSIGN     I CATALOG_ASSIGN                Catalog Determination                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUD_PERMCHECK     I CHECK_AUDIT_PERMISSIBILITY    Check Audit Permissibility                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUD_SETAORES      I CHANGE_RESULT                 Change Final Result                                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00AUTHORITY         I PROCESS_AUTHORITY_CHECK       Check Authorization for Activities                          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CANCELREASON      I SET_REASON                    Set Cancellation Reason                                     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CHECKSPECIAL      I CHECK_SPECIALIZATION          Plausibility Check for Academic Specializations             .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS           I GET_EXCLUDING_FCODES          Get List of Excluded Function Codes                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS           I PROCESS_FCODE                 Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS_DIST      I DISTRIBUTE_STUDENTS           Distribute Students of Cohort to Subcohorts                 .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS_NAME      I RENAME_SUBCOHORTS             Assign Default Names                                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS_SORT      I SORT_COBECTS                  Sort Context Objects                                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00COHORTS_SORT      I SORT_STUDENTS                 Sort Students                                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CONFERQGRADE      I CALCULATE                     Calculate Grade and Academic Honors                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CORR              I CORR_CHECK                    Check for Mandatory Fields for Correspondence Generation    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CORR              I CORR_WRITE                    Correspondence Generation                                   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CORR_MASSACTV     I CONT_CREATE                   Create Correspondence Containers                            .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00CORR_MASSACTV     I CONT_PRINT                    Print Correspondence Containers                             .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00EVENTSUBSCEXT     I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Get Subscreen                                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00EVOBJ_FILLEXP     I GET_PROCESS_EXPECTED          Get Expected Assessment Processes for Assessment            .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00EVOBJ_FILLEXP     I GET_PROCESS_EXPECTED_ST       Get Expected Assessment Processes for Student               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00EVOB_REGCHECK     I CHECK_REGISTRATION            Check When Opening Process                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00EX_DESCRBUILD     I BUILD_DESCRIPTION             Format Short Text                                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00FILTEROBJLIST     I FILTER_OBJECTS                Filter Object Set                                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00MODREG_UPDATE     I RECORDS_SAVED                 Data Records Updated                                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00MODULEREG0002     I ELIGIBILITY_CHECK             Check Admissibility of Booking                              .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00MODULEREG0003     I ELIGIBILITY_CHECK             Check Admissibility of Booking                              .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00MODULEREG_PBO     I DEFAULT_VALUES_GET            Set Default Values                                          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00MODULEREG_PBO     I ELIGIBILITY_CHECK             Check Admissibility of Booking                              .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PEPE_CHANG529     I RELATION_EVAL                 Override Result of Prerequisite Check                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PERIOD_MAP        I GET_SUBPERIODS                Get Lower-Level Sessions                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PERIOD_MAP        I PERIOD_CONVERT                Convert Academic Session                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PROC_DOC          I DISPLAY                       Display Activity Document                                   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PROG_GR           I ON_PROCESSED                  Execute Event Processing After Progression                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_MODBO     I GET_PROGC_VAR_TAB             Define Program Types for Module Booking Where-Used Entries  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_MODBO     I GET_PROG_GR_PTRELEVANT        Define Progr.Categories for Mod.Booking Where-Used Entries  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00REG0010           I REGPER_DEFAULT                Determine Default Values for Sessional Registration         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00REG0012           I SET_CHANGEOFPROG_DEFAULTS     Change Default Values for Change of Program                 .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00REG0090           I REGPROC_FOLLOW_UP             Trigger Subsequent Activity                                 .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00REG0160           I CHECK_ADMISSION_ALLOWED       Check If Admission Is Allowed                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00REQSEL            I REQUIREMENTS_GET              Determine Rule Containers for Requirements                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00RESOUDESCRPTN     I GET_RESOURCE_DESCRIPTION      Description of Business Event Resources                     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00RLCONDITION       I EVALUATE                      Condition Evaluation                                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SCHEDDESCRPTN     I GET_SCHEDULE_DESCRIPTION      Get Description of Business Event Schedule                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I CHANGE_VARIANT                Change Selection Variant                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I CHECK_VARIANT                 Check if Selection Variant Exists                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I CREATE_VARIANT                Create Selection Variant                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I DELETE_VARIANT                Delete Selection Variant                                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I DISPLAY_VARIANT               Display Selection Variant                                   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I GET_OBJECTS                   Determine Objects (Object Selection)                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I GET_PROPERTIES                Determine Selection Method Properties                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I GET_VARIANT_LIST              Get Selection Variant List                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I GET_VARIANT_TEXT              Determine Variant Description                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I INIT                          Initialize Selection Method                                 .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I IS_SUPPORTED_PDOTYPE          Check if Selection Method Supports the Object Type          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD         I VARISUBSCR_BEFORE_PBO         Do Not Use (Callup Point Before PBO of Variant Subscreen)   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SI2_PINDX_CAL     I CALCULATE                     Calculate Academic Performance Index                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SI2_PINDX_FIL     I FILTER                        Filter for Calculation Bases                                .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SI_CALCULATOR     I CALCULATE                     Calculate Average Grade                                     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SI_CALCULATOR     I GET_CALCULATOR_INFO           Get Technical Information for Average Grade                 .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SI_CALCULATOR     I GET_TEXTS                     Get Texts for Average Grade (Dynamic)                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SRM_RECDESCR      I DESCRIPTION_GET               Determine Record Number                                     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00SWITCHVALUE       I VALUE_CHANGE                  Value                                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00TLOADCALC         I CALC_TEACHLOAD                Calculate Individual Teacher's Workload                     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00WAITLIST_SORT     I SORT_WAITLIST                 Sort Waiting List                                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00WLWFACTDET        I SET_WFACTOR                   Determine Weighting Factor                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_AGR_PERIOD       I GET_DEFAULT_PERIOD            Determine Academic Session for Appraiser                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ALUMNUS_ORG      I DEFINE_ALUMNUS_RELAT_EARLY    Def'n of Org. Unit for Alumnus Before Standard Derivation   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ALUMNUS_ORG      I DEFINE_ALUMNUS_RELAT_LATE     Def'n of Org. Unit for Alumnus After Standard Derivation    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_CMROLE           I GET_STATUS                    Determine Statuses for Student                              .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_EDFUP            I EVALUATE_FOLLOW_UP            Change Credits of Internal Academic Work                    .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ED_PERIOD        I DETERMINE_PERIODS             Determine Acad. Period for Transferred Work/Qualification   .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GB_POINTSCAL     I CALCULATE_POINTS              Calculate Exam Points                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GET_CAOBJECT     I GET_CAOBJECT                  Get CA Object                                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GRADEAPPSER      I SET_APPRAISERLIST             Create Appraiser List                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GRADEFUP         I EVALUATE_FOLLOW_UP            Evaluate Follow-Up                                          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GRADESYM_VAL     I CHECK_GRADESYM                Check for Allowed Grade Symbols                             .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_GRADING          I CHANGE_APPR_ADMIN             Change of Appraisal Management Data                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ISR_CHK_ATTR     I CHECK_ATTRIBUTE               Comparison of Request Data and Master Data                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_SET_STATIND      I SET_STATIND                   Set Status Indicators                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_SE_SHORT         I GET_PACKAGE_SHORT_TEXT        Determine Business Event Package (Short Text)               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST00_FCODE       I GET_EXCLUDING_FCODES          Get List of Excluded Function Codes                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST00_FCODE       I PROCESS_FCODE                 Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST00_TAB         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization check                                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDENT_ORGUNIT_DERIVE_EARLY  Derive Org. Unit for Student Before Standard Process        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDENT_ORGUNIT_DERIVE_LATE   Derive Org. Unit for Student After Standard Process         .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDENT_ORGUNIT_GET_EARLY     Determine Org. Unit for Student Before Standard Process     .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDENT_ORGUNIT_GET_LATE      Determine Org. Unit for Student After Standard Process      .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDY_ORGUNIT_DERIVE_EARLY    Derive Org. Unit for Study Before Standard Process          .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_STUDENT_ORG      I STUDY_ORGUNIT_DERIVE_LATE     Derive Org. Unit for Study After Standard Process           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_ACCOUNT       I MODIFY_CONTRACT_ACCOUNT_FIELDSChange Contract Account Fields                              .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_ACCOUNT       I MODIFY_CONTRACT_OBJECT_FIELDS Change Contract Object Fields                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_ADVISOR       I BUILD_HEADER_LINE             Build Header Data                                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_ADVISOR       I GETLIST                       Get List of Advisors                                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_HD_HS         I BUILD_STATUS_LINE             Student Header Structure (Status Line)                      .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_INACTIVE      I CHECK_INACTIVE_STUDENT        Activation Check for Set of Students                        .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_NUMBER        I CHECK                         Check External Student Number                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQ00_ST_NUMBER        I GET_NEXT                      Request New Student Number                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQGB_HESA_HUSID       I GET_NEXT_NUMBER               Get next number for HUSID                                   .
IF_EX_HRPIQGB_UCAS_ADDRESS     I RESOLVE_ADDRESS               Change the Address Mapping                                  .
IF_EX_HRPIQGB_UCAS_ADDRESS     I STORE_ADDRESS                 Store the Address in Further Tables                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQMSGCNTL             I GET_OVERRIDE_PERMISSION       Get Boolean Value (Permission to Override Message?)         .
IF_EX_HRPIQUSIPEDS_DISCIP      I DISC_TO_CIPCODE               Convert Discipline to CIPCODE                               .
IF_EX_HRPIQUS_NSCH             I CHANGE_CIPCODE_DATA           Change CIPCODE Derivation                                   .
IF_EX_HRPIQUS_NSCH             I CHANGE_ST_PERSONAL_DATA       Fill personal data of the student                           .
IF_EX_HRPIQUS_VETERANS         I CHANGE_FACILITY_CODE          Change Facility Code, Contract School Address, Campus ID    .
IF_EX_HRPIQUS_VETERANS         I CHANGE_SC_DATA                Change Program Data                                         .
IF_EX_HRPIQUS_VETERANS         I CHANGE_SM_DATA                Change Module Data                                          .
IF_EX_HRPY_HK_PC270006         I PC270006                      Treatment of Retro Diff. in Payroll Results before IR56B gen.
IF_EX_HRPY_LOAN_PAYMENTS       I ADD_PAYMENTS                  Make Additional Payments                                    .
IF_EX_HRPY_LOAN_REPORTING      I ACCOUNT_STATEMENT_HEADER      Header of Bank Statement                                    .
IF_EX_HRPY_WAGE_COMPONENT      I ADD_WAGE_COMP_DETAILS         Additional Data for Salary Elements or Check                .
IF_EX_HRPY_WAGE_COMPONENT      I DISPLAY_ADDED_DETAILS         Export Additional Data                                      .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_DOC_UPLOAD       I CHECK_ATTACH_FILE_SIZE        Checks Size of Document                                     .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_DOC_UPLOAD       I CHECK_ATTACH_FILE_TYPE        Checks File Format                                          .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_DOC_UPLOAD       I CHECK_NUMBER_OF_ATTACH        Checks Number of Attachments                                .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_DOC_UPLOAD       I CHECK_VIRUS                   Checks document for viruses                                 .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_DOC_UPLOAD       I CONVERT_FILE_TYPE             Converts File Format                                        .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_QUERY_LOG        I IS_LOG_ACTIVE                 Logging Active?                                             .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_SEARCH_LOG       I IS_LOG_ACTIVE                 Log?                                                        .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_SEARCH_RANKING   I COMPUTE_RANKING               Group Together Hits from Two Searches with OR or AND        .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_SEARCH_RANKING   I COMPUTE_RANKING_FOR_MAND_LIST Compare Hits from Searches with or w/out Mandatory Criteria .
IF_EX_HRRCF00_SEARCH_RANKING   I COMPUTE_RANKING_NON_TREX_HITS Calculate Weighting of Hits from Non-TREX Search            .
IF_EX_HRRCF04_STORE_HRSKIL     I STORE_IT5105_INTO_HRSKILLS    E-Rec. Save Qualifications in an HR Qualification Database  .
IF_EX_HRRCF_SEARCH_LOG         I IS_LOG_ACTIVE                 Is Logging To Be Performed?                                 .
IF_EX_HRSEN_VALUATION_MODL     I EVALUATE_DURATION             Calculate Duration Using a Valuation Model                  .
IF_EX_HRSPA_EDITSCREEN         I EDIT_SCREEN_GET               Get the specific edit screen and edit program               .
IF_EX_HRSPA_EDITSCREEN         I HEADER_SCREENS_GET            Get the header screens and header program                   .
IF_EX_HRSPA_SUBSCREENS         I EDIT_SCREEN_GET               Get the specific edit screen and edit program               .
IF_EX_HRSPA_SUBSCREENS         I HEADER_SCREENS_GET            Get the header screens and header program                   .
IF_EX_HRSPPBS_ADD_CHECKS       I DO_ADD_CHECKS                 Additional Checks for Shifts in HR-SP                       .
IF_EX_HRSPPBS_ADD_CHECKS       I DO_BALANCE_LINE_UPDATE        Immediate Cell Valuation of Hourly Balance Line             .
IF_EX_HRSPPBS_ADD_CHECKS       I DO_INFOCOLUMN_UPDATE          Immediate Valuation of Info Columns in HR-SP                .
IF_EX_HRSYNC_P                 I CHANGE_USER_ORDER             Change Sequence When Determining Users                      .
IF_EX_HRSYNC_P                 I COMPOSE_CP_NAME               Overrides Composition of CP Name                            .
IF_EX_HRSYNC_P                 I CONVERT_HR_TO_BP              Convert HR Data by Business Partner                         .
IF_EX_HRSYNC_P                 I DO_POST_PROCESSING            Additional Follow-Up Processing After Creating BP           .
IF_EX_HRSYNC_P                 I MAP_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS         Folders of Additional Info Type Fields to BP                .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I AFTER_UPDATE                  Update Task Bracket (After Update)                          .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Update Task Bracket (Before Update)                         .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REGISTER_HEADER               Complete header area on data screen                         .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REGISTER_OTYPES               Add allowed object types                                    .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REGISTER_OTYPE_PROPERTIES     Determine attributes of an object type                      .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REGISTER_SUBSCREENS           Change infotype screens supported                           .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_CREATE_ANY_OBJECT     Replace create object                                       .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_EDIT_ANY_OBJECT       Replace display/create object                               .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_EVENT                 Replace action                                              .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_EVENT_2               Replace Action (on Switch to Data Screen)                   .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_GUI_STATUS            Change GUI status                                           .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_POPUP_RELATION        Dialog Box: Enter Relationships                             .
IF_EX_HRTEM00MASTERDATA        I REPLACE_RELAT_TIMCO           Specifications for relationships                            .
IF_EX_HRTEM00NET_ACTIVITY      I HRTEM_GET_WF_EVENTS           Read Workflow Events                                        .
IF_EX_HRTEM00NET_ACTIVITY      I RH_GET_ATTENDEE_ACTIVITIES    Read activities of an event attendee                        .
IF_EX_HRTEM00NET_WEBST         I GET_CANCELLATION_REASON       Determine cancellation reason for ESS                       .
IF_EX_HRTEM_CORR_NOTIF_REQ     I SET_NOTIFICATION_REQUEST      Switch Off Receipt / Read Confirmation for Mail             .
IF_EX_HRTEM_HANDLE_BOOKING     I SET_CANCELATION               Create Cancellation When Employee Leaves Company            .
IF_EX_HRTEM_INT_ZW             I CHANGE_AVAIL                  Change Availability Records from HR_PERSONAL_TIME_LIST      .
IF_EX_HRTEM_INT_ZW             I ERROR_HANDLING                Update Time Management Records at Error                     .
IF_EX_HRTEM_INT_ZW             I MODIFY_2002                   Change Time Management Records Before Update                .
IF_EX_HRTEM_READ_OBJECT        I SET_NAME                      Name format                                                 .
IF_EX_HRTIM_COV_HISTORY        I HR_COV_CHECK_AB_RECORD        Is AB record to be processed in function XNAB?              .
IF_EX_HRTIM_UCCONV_COVER       I HR_UCCONV_DDIC_STRUC_COVER    DDIC Structure for MARK Field of Table COVER                .
IF_EX_HRWPC00_HEADCNT2CO       I GET_KEYFIGURE                 Statistical Key Figures for Headcount                       .
IF_EX_HRWPC_EREC_ADD_VALS      I MANIPULATE_ADD_VALUES         Enhance value help (F4) for Req Forms                       .
IF_EX_HRWPC_EREC_DATE          I MANIPULATE_DATE               Adjust Date on Requisition Forms                            .
IF_EX_HRWPC_EREC_MGR_GRP       I EVALUATE_MGR_GROUPING         Assign Manager in groupings                                 .
IF_EX_HRWPC_EREC_RECRUITER     I MANIPULATE_ACTOR_TAB          Change agent table for role resolution                      .
IF_EX_HRWPC_EXCL_MANAGERS      I EXCLUDE_MANAGER               Excludes Manager                                            .
IF_EX_HRWPC_MOD_NAVOBJECTS     I GET_TEXTS                     Delivers Display Texts for Navigation Objects               .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_ADD_VALUES     I MANIPULATE_ADD_VALUES         Adjust value help for change request forms                  .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_APPR_FORM      I MANIPULATE_ACTOR_TAB          Change Agent Table for Rule Resolution                      .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_APPR_NEXT      I MANIPULATE_ACTOR_TAB          Change Agent Table for Rule Resolution                      .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_CHECK_DATE     I CHECK_EFFECTIVE_DATE          Customer-Specific Check of Effective Date                   .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_EEGRP          I EVALUATE_EE_GROUPING          Adjust assignment employee - employee grouping              .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_EFF_DATE       I MANIPULATE_EFF_DATE           Adjust Effective Date in Change Request Forms               .
IF_EX_HRWPC_PCR_INIT           I MANIPULATE_INIT_DATA          Adjust header data in change request forms                  .
IF_EX_HRWPC_RC_SHORTPROFIL     I MANIPULATE_HTML_SHORTPROFILE  Adjust HTML format in applicant short profiles              .
IF_EX_HRWPC_RQ_APPR_FORM       I MANIPULATE_ACTOR_TAB          Change agent table for rule resolution                      .
IF_EX_HRWPC_RQ_APPR_NEXT       I MANIPULATE_ACTOR_TAB          Change Agent Table for Rule Resolution                      .
IF_EX_HRWTT00HTML              I GET_HTML_TABLE                Get the HTML data for display on the HTML control           .
IF_EX_HRWTT00SELECTION         I SHOW_SELECTION_SCREEN         Display Selection Screen and return selected Wage Types     .
IF_EX_HRWTT00TOOLS             I GET_TOOLS_LIST                Get the list of related tools for a wage type               .
IF_EX_HRWTT00WIZARDS           I GET_WIZARDS_LIST              Get the list of wage type configuration wizards             .
IF_EX_HR_15_DM10               I METHOD                        table edit                                                  .
IF_EX_HR_15_DM10               I METHOD2                       Change flag                                                 .
IF_EX_HR_15_DM10               I MODIFY_TAB_CALCOLO            Modify Tabella_calcolo to edit values of DM10 codes         .
IF_EX_HR_BE_BADI_RPDTXAB0      I METHOD01                      User exit 001                                               .
IF_EX_HR_BE_BADI_RPDTXAB0      I METHOD04                      User exit 004                                               .
IF_EX_HR_BE_BADI_RPDTXAB0      I METHOD05                      User exit 005                                               .
IF_EX_HR_BE_BADI_RPDTXAB0      I METHOD06                      User exit 006                                               .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_ACCT_PRORATE      I GET_ACCT_PRORATE_RULE         Determine the benefit point account prorating rule.         .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_ADJ_REIMBURSE     I ADJ_REIMBURSE_AMT             Adjustment reimburstment amount for BPS                     .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_B_PRORATE         I GET_ACCT_PRORATE_RULE         Prorating basic points                                      .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_CALC_ADDPOINT     I CALC_ADDITIONAL_POINTS        Calculate additional points for benefit points system       .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_CARRY_RULE        I GET_ACCT_CARRY_RULE           Carry over points from previous account period              .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_FILL_PME97        I FILL_STRUCTURE_PME97          Fill structure pme97 for customer                           .
IF_EX_HR_BPS_T_PRORATE         I GET_ACCT_PRORATE_RULE         Prorating total points                                      .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARNISHMENT        I CALCULATE_NUMBER_SALARIES     Calculate requested amount from number of salaries          .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARNISHMENT        I GENERATE_WAGETYPES            Generates additional wagetypes from garnishment result      .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARNISHMENT        I SELECT_OLD_PAYROLLS           Returns the old payroll results that need to be imported    .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_GENWGTYP      I GENERATE_WAGETYPES_FROM_CURR  Generates additional payrolls according to current result   .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_GENWGTYP      I GENERATE_WAGETYPES_FROM_OLD   Generates additional payrolls according to old results      .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_GENWGTYP      I SELECT_OLD_PAYROLLS           Provides old payroll results to be imported                 .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_UNIT          I CALCULATE_NUMBER_SALARIES     Calculate requested amount from the number of salaries      .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_WAGETYPE      I GENERATE_WAGETYPES            Creates additional payrolls according to alimony result     .
IF_EX_HR_BR_GARN_WAGETYPE      I SELECT_OLD_PAYROLLS           Provides old payroll results to be imported                 .
IF_EX_HR_BR_IR_DEP_ELIG        I EVALUATE_ELIGIBILITY          Valuates if dependent and eligible for rebate of IR         .
IF_EX_HR_BR_QUOTA_HIREFIRE     I GET_HIRE_FIRE_DATE            Get hiring and dismissal dates for quota calculation        .
IF_EX_HR_CE_GEN_PERSONID_EXT   I GET_PERSONID_EXT              Get personid_ext                                            .
IF_EX_HR_CH_READ_ABREINH       I READ_ABREINHEIT               Read Payroll Unit                                           .
IF_EX_HR_CH_RPLQSTC3           I CHANGE_OUTPUT_EE              Enhance or Change Output Structure (Employee Data)          .
IF_EX_HR_CH_RPLQSTCI           I GET_CUST_DATA                 Fill Additional Fields                                      .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_GRANT_INFO        I GET_LTI_GRANT_INFO            Get all relevant LTI grants information                     .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_PAR_ADDI_INFO     I GET_EMPLOYEE_ADDITIONAL_INFO  Get additional information about the employee               .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_PAR_CONT_INFO     I GET_EMPLOYEE_CONTACT_INFO     Get contact information about the employee                  .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_PAR_NAME_INFO     I GET_EMPLOYEE_NAME_INFO        Get all information about the name of employee              .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_PAR_POST_INFO     I GET_EMPLOYEE_POSTAL_ADDRESS   Get all information about post address of employee          .
IF_EX_HR_ECM_PAR_TAX_INFO      I GET_EMPLOYEE_TAX_INFO         Get all relevant tax information about employee             .
IF_EX_HR_EFI_DETPERNR          I DETERMINE_PERNR               Determine the pernr from the works number                   .
IF_EX_HR_EFI_UPD0065           I CHECK_0065_UPDATE             Check the record to be updated to infotype 0065             .
IF_EX_HR_EFI_UPD0070           I CHECK_0070_UPDATE             Check the record to be updated to infotype 0065             .
IF_EX_HR_EFI_UPD0757           I CHECK_0757_UPDATE             Check the record to be updated to infotype 0757             .
IF_EX_HR_F4_GET_SUBTYPE        I GET_SUBTYPE_TEXT              Define Text for Subtype                                     .
IF_EX_HR_F4_GET_SUBTYPE        I GET_TAB_F4_HELP               Determine Tables for Entry Help                             .
IF_EX_HR_FAST_ACTION_CHECK     I CHECK_FIELDS                  Verification of Fields                                      .
IF_EX_HR_FI_HPA                I DETERMINE_BONUS_DAYS          Determine Bonus Days for Holiday Pay Accrual                .
IF_EX_HR_FI_HPA                I DETERMINE_DAILY_RATE          Determine Daily rates for Holiday pay Accrual               .
IF_EX_HR_FI_IT0057             I CHECK_COMBO                   Get default values from trade union tables in PAI           .
IF_EX_HR_FI_IT0057             I SET_FI_DEFAULTS               Initialize obligatory fields in PBO                         .
IF_EX_HR_INDVAL                I DO_INDIRECT_VALUATION         Execution of Indirect Valuation                             .
IF_EX_HR_INLK_ESI_REPORT       I GET_SYSUBRC_CHANGE            Change SY-SUBRC For INLK                                    .
IF_EX_HR_IN_BANK_TRANSFER      I GET_TAX_BANK_DETAILS          Get Bank Details where tax is deposited                     .
IF_EX_HR_IN_CCO_PROCESSING     I GET_EXEMPTION                 Exemption calculation                                       .
IF_EX_HR_IN_CCO_PROCESSING     I GET_PERK                      Perk calculation                                            .
IF_EX_HR_IN_CLAIMS_PAYMENT     I GET_CLAIMS_TAB                Data from Claims_tab to be passed to user exit              .
IF_EX_HR_IN_CLAIMS_PAYMENT     I GET_RETR_TAB                  Data from user exit to be retreived and passed to Claims_tab.
IF_EX_HR_IN_ER_ADDRESS         I GET_ER_ADDRESS                To get address of the employer                              .
IF_EX_HR_IN_ESI_REFUND         I DECIDE_ESI_REFUND             Decide whether ESI refund is to be done to the employee     .
IF_EX_HR_IN_F24Q_TXBL_INCM     I GET_TAXABLE_INCOME            To get the taxable income for Form 24Q                      .
IF_EX_HR_IN_LOANS_VALIDATE     I GET_ASSET_VALUE               Get asset value                                             .
IF_EX_HR_IN_LOANS_VALIDATE     I GET_LOAN_APPROVED             Get maximum  amount that can be approved for a loan type    .
IF_EX_HR_IN_LOANS_VALIDATE     I GET_LOAN_MAX_VALUES           Get values for max. no loans at a time & cum.&  outstnd amt .
IF_EX_HR_IN_MINIMUM_NET        I GET_MINIMUM_NET               Process and return minimum net amount                       .
IF_EX_HR_IN_PERCENT_SHARES     I GET_PERCENT_SHARES            To get percentage of shares held by each employee           .
IF_EX_HR_IN_PF_REP_MARCH       I GET_MARCH_DATA                Get March Data From Legacy System for PF Report             .
IF_EX_HR_IN_PF_REP_MARCH       I GET_MARCH_DATA_PEN            Get March Data From Legacy System for Pen Report            .
IF_EX_HR_IN_TAX_EMPLOYER       I GET_EMPLOYER_TAX              get the tax paid by the employer on behalf of the employee  .
IF_EX_HR_IT0002                I PERID_CHECK                   Check the personal ID                                       .
IF_EX_HR_IT0002                I PERID_EXIST_CHECK             Check if the personal ID already exists                     .
IF_EX_HR_IT0002                I PERID_GBDAT_CHECK             Check if date of birth and personal ID do correlate         .
IF_EX_HR_IT0002                I PERID_GESCH_CHECK             Check if gender and personal ID do correlate                .
IF_EX_HR_IT0002                I SET_OUTPUT_VALUES             Set length and attributes                                   .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I CONVERTI_SCATTI_DA_T5ITS      Converts previous pay scale jumps in case of category change.
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I GET_TIPO_SCA_8                Assigns the pay scale jump type for range 80 - 89           .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I GET_TIPO_SCA_9                Assigns the pay scale jump type for range 90 - 99           .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I INIT_NEW_0008                 Initializes NEW_0008 (new data for infotype 8)              .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I PROCESS_OTHERS                Processes non-standard pay scale jump types                 .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I READ_T5ITS                    Read table T5ITS*                                           .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I RIVALUTA_DA_T5ITS             Revaluates pay scale jumps already available                .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SCATTI_DIVERSI     I VALORIZZAZIONE_DA_T5ITS       New pay scale jumps                                         .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I ABSORB_SUPERMINIMUM           Assorbimento del superminimo                                .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I ACTIVATE_SEL_SCREEN           Attivazione campi di gestione del superminimo della videata .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I CALCULATE_GROSS_SALARIES      Calcola i salari lordi teorici                              .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I CALCULATE_SUPERMINIMUM        Calcola il nuovo superminimo                                .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I FINALIZATION                  Operazioni di chiusura dell'oggetto                         .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I INITIALIZATION                Inizializzazione dell'oggetto                               .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I IS_MODIFIED                   Se il CID e' stato modificato                               .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I PROCESSING                    Elaborazione del CID per l'assorbimento del superminimo     .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I SHOW_RESULTS                  Visualizzazione informazioni relative ai CID elaborati      .
IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN             I TO_BE_PROCESSED               Se il CID deve essere elaborato                             .
IF_EX_HR_LA_SHOW_TRM_PYMNT     I LGART_FOR_DISPLAY             Returns range of wage types according to aklas (table T512W).
IF_EX_HR_LA_TRM_ACTION         I ADJUST_INFOTYPES              Adjust/delimit infotypes for a given action                 .
IF_EX_HR_LA_TRM_PRENOTICE      I GET_PRENOTICE_DAYS            Obtain days of prenotice for quota generation               .
IF_EX_HR_MX_HMXCAFL0_EDI       I FILL_EDI_FORMAT               Fill EDI format IMSS transfer                               .
IF_EX_HR_MX_HMXUTMS0_EDI       I OBTAIN_STRUC_TABLE_TYPE       Obtains EDI format message and table type                   .
IF_EX_HR_MX_STATE_TAX          I DETERMINE_BASE_FOR_STATE_TAX  Determination of the basis for the state tax calculation    .
IF_EX_HR_MX_STATE_TAX          I DETERMINE_STATE_FOR_STATE_TAX Determination of the state for the state tax calculation    .
IF_EX_HR_MX_STATE_TAX          I OBTAIN_STATE_TAX              Determination of the state tax                              .
IF_EX_HR_MX_TRM_VAC_DAYS       I LIQUIDATE                     Calculates the number of days to be settled on termination  .
IF_EX_HR_MX_VSDI_KEY_DATE      I VSDI_KEY_DATE_FOR_CUMM_PERIOD Determine key date for SDI variant cumulation period        .
IF_EX_HR_NOPBS_IV_EXIT1        I IND_VAL_METHOD                User Exit for the Indirect Valuation                        .
IF_EX_HR_NOPBS_SPK1            I HR_NOPBS_SPK1_METHOD          Method to change the final file                             .
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_ABSDATA        I CHANGE_ABSENCE_DATA           Influence the absence and re-imbursement amount calculated. .
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_CLAIMINFO      I CHANGE_CLAIM_INFO             influence claim information which is going into the cluster..
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_MPOS           I READ_MPOS_INFO                Read Multiple Positions                                     .
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_NOPYRESULT     I READ_ADDITIONAL_INFO          Read required data if no prev. payroll results are available.
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_PAYDATA        I READ_ADDITIONAL_DATA          additional data  after reading previous 3 payroll results   .
IF_EX_HR_NO_RMB_RCON           I RECONCILIATION                Reconciliation of claim and received payments               .
IF_EX_HR_NZ_GET_BEGDA          I GET_BEGIN_DATE                Returns the begin date using the 52 week calculation method .
IF_EX_HR_NZ_PAY_TERM_GROSS     I GET_TERM_GROSS                Gets values of gross to be used for termination accrual pay .
IF_EX_HR_NZ_PAY_TERM_PUHOL     I GET_TERM_PHPAY                Gets the rate to be used to pay termination public holidays .
IF_EX_HR_PAD_CHECKS_ICTYP      I CHECK_ICTYP                   All ICNum checks specific to the ICTYP and molga            .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_ASAF           I M_PROCESS_SALREF              Process the reference salary                                .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_ASMF           I M_PROCESS_ABSENCE             Process the absence data                                    .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_ASMF           I M_PROCESS_SALREF              Process the reference salary                                .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_REF_PERIOD     I M_GEN_CALE                    Check of the calendar generation                            .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_REF_PERIOD     I M_GET_COMPENSATED_DAYS        Process all parameters before updating the NCALE            .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_REF_PERIOD     I M_PROCESS_OVERLAPPING_EXT     Process overlapping absences when period=calendar year      .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_REF_PERIOD     I M_PROCESS_USER_CRITERION      Process user criteria                                       .
IF_EX_HR_PAY_06_TIME           I EXIT_SAPLHRPAYFRABS1_002      Define Grace Period Duration via a BADI                     .
IF_EX_HR_PF_ACCOUNT            I READ_ACCOUNT                  Read additional information for a posting line              .
IF_EX_HR_PF_ACCOUNT            I WRITE_TO_ACCOUNT              Write additional information to a posting line              .
IF_EX_HR_PM_BUILD_PARCEL       I BUILD_PACEL_TEXT              Creates the Text for a Set for the Process Workbench        .
IF_EX_HR_PM_BUILD_PARCEL       I BUILD_PARCEL                  Create Sets                                                 .
IF_EX_HR_PM_BUILD_PARCEL       I BUILD_TEXT                    Text for Display                                            .
IF_EX_HR_PM_BUILD_PARCEL       I CHECK_CRITERION               Check Criteria                                              .
IF_EX_HR_PM_BUILD_PARCEL       I GET_NEXT_PARCEL               Transfers Set                                               .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I CHANGE_STEPID                 Adjust Process Step Numbers                                 .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I CLEAR_DYNPRO_DATA             Delete Data on Screen                                       .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I EXECUTE_PARCEL                Execute Wait Point                                          .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I GET_DATA_TYPE                 Retrieve Table Type of Wait Point Data                      .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I GET_DYNPRO_DATA               Transfer Data From Screen to Process Model                  .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I GET_DYNPRO_INFO               Retrieve Programs, Screens, and Tab Page Title              .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I INIT_DYNPRO                   Initialize Screen and Set Mode                              .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I INIT_START                    Prepare Execution                                           .
IF_EX_HR_PM_WAITING_POINT      I SET_DYNPRO_DATA               Transfer Data to Screen                                     .
IF_EX_HR_PY_AUTH_PU01          I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Customer authorization check                                .
IF_EX_HR_PY_CLST_DISP          I NOTIFY_DISPLAY                Table is Displayed                                          .
IF_EX_HR_PY_ENQUEUE            I ADD_ACTION                    Execute Additional Activity                                 .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I CLEAR_DYNPRO_DATA             Deletes Data on Screen                                      .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I DELETE_EVENTS                 Delete an Event                                             .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I DELETE_EVENT_PROBLEMS         Delete an Event                                             .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I EVENT_USED                    Are Entries Available                                       .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I GET_CONTRA_EVENT              Get Counterevents                                           .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I GET_DYNPRO_DATA               Get Data From Screen                                        .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I GET_DYNPRO_INFO               Supplies Report and Screen for Maintenance                  .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I INIT_DYNPRO                   Initialization of Subscreen                                 .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I INSERT_CONTRA_EVENT           Insert a Counterevent                                       .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I INSERT_EVENT                  Insert an Event                                             .
IF_EX_HR_PY_EVENTS_DEAL        I SET_DYNPRO_DATA               Provides Data on Screen                                     .
IF_EX_HR_PY_OUT_OF_SEQ         I CHECK_PAYDT                   Further Restriction of Payment Date                         .
IF_EX_HR_PY_OUT_OF_SEQ         I CHECK_YEA                     Allow YEA Below the 6-Month Window                          .
IF_EX_HR_PY_OUT_OF_SEQ         I GET_GROUPING_REASON_A         Grouping Reason for Bonus Payments 'XXPY' or 'XNON'         .
IF_EX_HR_PY_OUT_OF_SEQ         I GET_GROUPING_REASON_C         Grouping Reason for NAMCs 'XXPY' or 'XNON'                  .
IF_EX_HR_PY_SEL_PROG_DEAL      I SET_ADD_INFO_BEFORE_START     Determines Additional Selection Parameters                  .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I DELETE_OBJECT                 Deletes Objects                                             .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I DETERMINE_OFFER_OF_STEP       Determines Objects of a Step (2 Categories)                 .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I DETERMINE_RESULT_OF_STEP      Determines Objects of a Step (3 Categories)                 .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_ALL_OBJECTS_OF_STEP       Delivers All Objects in a Step                              .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_CHILDREN_TO_RESET         Checks if Status can be Reset for Lower-Level Steps         .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_DELETE         Finds Objects That May be Deleted                           .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_DELETE_CM      Finds Objects That May be Deleted                           .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_DISPLAY        Finds Objects to be Displayed                               .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_RESET          Searches for Objects Whose Status can be Reset              .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_SETSUCC        Seraches for object whose status may be set to successful   .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I GET_OBJECTS_TO_SETSUCC_CM     Seraches for object whose status may be set to successful   .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I INSERT_OBJECTS                Inserts New Objects                                         .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I SET_STATUS                    Sets Status of Objects                                      .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I SET_STATUS_ERR                Sets Status of all Objects to Incorrect                     .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I SET_STATUS_INI                Sets Status of all Objects to Initial                       .
IF_EX_HR_PY_STATUS_DEAL        I SET_STATUS_SUCC               Sets the status of all objects to successful                .
IF_EX_HR_RHPREL00              I GET_ACTIVE_PERIOD             Returns Active Existence Period of Person                   .
IF_EX_HR_SE_ADJUST_ABSENCE     I CHANGE_ABSENCE_LISTS          Change modifiable list and manual check list                .
IF_EX_HR_SE_AVE_PAID_LST3Y     I AVER_PAID_LAST_3_YEAR         average payment of commission and bonus in last 3 years     .
IF_EX_HR_SE_GET_SSYK           I GET_EE_SSYK_CODE              Getting employee's SSYK code (4 pos) for Swedish reports    .
IF_EX_HR_SE_GET_SSYK_CODE      I GET_EE_SSYK_CODE              Getting employee's SSYK code for Sweden reports             .
IF_EX_HR_SE_GET_WORKPLACE      I GET_WORKPLACE_NUMBER          Getting employee's workplace number                         .
IF_EX_HR_SE_GET_WORK_PLACE     I GET_WORK_PLACE_NUMBER         Getting the employee's work place number                    .
IF_EX_HR_UPD_NZ_NZHPI          I GET_NZHPI_VALUES              Gets values of gross, hours and days to be updated to NZHPI .
IF_EX_HR_VE_TRM_FORCE_RETR     I GET_SUBTYPES_FOR_RETRO        Selects subtypes that require retroactive calculation       .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_DISCI          I GET_DISCI                     Get Disciplinary Actions                                    .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_ETHNIC         I GET_ETHNIC                    Get Ethnic Origin                                           .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_OCCAT          I GET_OCCAT                     Get Occupational Category                                   .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_OCLEV          I GET_OCLEV                     Get Occupational Level                                      .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_PERMS          I GET_PERMS                     Get Permanent/Non-Permanent Status                          .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_PROMO          I GET_PROMO                     Get Promotions                                              .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_RECRU          I GET_RECRU                     Get Recruitment Actions                                     .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_REMUN          I GET_REMUN                     Get Remuneration Amount                                     .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_SMARTFORM      I SET_SF_DEFAULTS               Set Smart Form defaults                                     .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_TERMI          I GET_TERMI                     Get Termination Actions                                     .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_EEA_TRAIN          I GET_TRAIN                     Get Training Participation                                  .
IF_EX_HR_ZA_NQF_DEFAULTS       I NQF_SCREEN                    Set the screen number for NQF catalog and details           .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_001             I HM_HEADER_DEL_CHECK           Checks When Deleting Hazardous Substance Master Records     .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_002             I MODIFY_HSDATA_AFTER_RECEIVING Modify Hazardous Substance Data After Receiving             .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_002             I MODIFY_HSDATA_BEFORE_SENDING  Modify Hazardous Substance Data Before Distributing         .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_002             I TRANSFER_EXTENSIONTAB_2_IOTAB Receive Own Data                                            .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_002             I TRANSFER_IOTAB_2_EXTENSIONTAB Send Own Data                                               .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_003             I SOLVE_CONFLICT_MULT_INST      Resolution of Multiple Values for Value Assignment Types    .
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_003             I SOLVE_CONFLICT_MULT_SUB       Resolution of 1:n Relationships Betw. Mat. (1) and Spec. (n).
IF_EX_HSM_BADI_003             I SPECIFICATIONS_FILTER         Filtering of Specifications for Hazardous Substance Filling .
IF_EX_HU_PREQ                  I CHECK_ASSIGNMENT              Check Assignments                                           .
IF_EX_IAOM_ATTRIBUTES          I CHANGE_ATTRBTS                Changes Chars of CO Account Assignment to Be Created/Changed.
IF_EX_IAOM_ATTRIBUTES          I CHANGE_SUB_OBJ_ATTRS          Changes Characteristics of Subobject Definition             .
IF_EX_IAOM_BUSINESS_SCENAR     I CHANGE_BUSINESS_SCENARIO_GROUPChange Business Scenario Group                              .
IF_EX_IAOM_BUSINESS_SCENAR     I CHANGE_ORDER_TYPE             Order Type for GeCCo (Internal Order)                       .
IF_EX_IAOM_BUSINESS_SCENAR     I CHANGE_PROJECT_PROFILE        Change Project Profile for Automatically Created PS Project .
IF_EX_IAOM_BUSINESS_SCENAR     I CHANGE_REQ_PRCTR_PROFSEGM     Accnt Assgnmnt to Profit Center/Profitability Seg.Necessary?.
IF_EX_IAOM_CSCUST_DEFAULTS     I SET_FIELD_DEFAULTS            Set Default Values for Fields of CO Sceanrio Customizing    .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_CHECK          I CHANGE_VIEW_CSC               Changes View "view_csc" in MODULE iaom_check_data_csc       .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_CHECK          I CHANGE_VIEW_CTP               Changes View "view_ctp" in MODULE iaom_check_data_ctp       .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_CHECK          I CHECK_VIEW_CSC                Checks View "view_csc" in MODULE iaom_check_data_csc        .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_CHECK          I CHECK_VIEW_CTP                Checks View "view_ctp" in MODULE iaom_check_data_ctp        .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_MASKS          I CHANGE_CUST_MASKS_CSC         Maskings for Determining the Controlling Scenario           .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_MASKS          I CHANGE_CUST_MASKS_CTP         Maskings for Determining Controlling Type and Usage Ref.    .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_MASKS          I INTERPRET_CUST_MASKS_CSC      Interpretation of Customizing for ... CSC                   .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_MASKS          I INTERPRET_CUST_MASKS_CTP      Interpretation of Customizing for ... CTP                   .
IF_EX_IAOM_CUST_XPRA           I XPRA_ON_THE_FLY               Conversion of Customizing Tables                            .
IF_EX_IAOM_DET_CO_SCENARIO     I DETERMINE_CO_SCENARIO         Determination of CO Scenario                                .
IF_EX_IAOM_ERROR_EVENTS        I ADJUST_FOR_ACTICITY_IAO5      IAOM_ACCOUNT_MANAGER: Postprocessing for Transaction IAO5   .
IF_EX_IAOM_ERROR_EVENTS        I ERROR_OCCURRED                IAOM_ACCOUNT_MANAGER: Exception ERROR_OCCURRED              .
IF_EX_IAOM_ERROR_EVENTS        I NO_ERROR_OCCURED              IAOM_ACCOUNT_MANAGER: Processing Without Error              .
IF_EX_IAOM_KOSTL               I CHANGE_COST_CENTER            Cost Center Change for CRM-CO Integration                   .
IF_EX_IAOM_LSTAR               I CHANGE_LSTAR                  Change activity type                                        .
IF_EX_IAOM_MESSAGES            I CHANGE_MESSAGE                Change Output                                               .
IF_EX_IAOM_PROCESS_CONTROL     I CONTROL_PROPERTIES_AC         Change Acct Assgmt Man. Attributes After Reading Customizing.
IF_EX_IAOM_RECEIVER            I CHANGE_RECEIVER               Change Recipient                                            .
IF_EX_IBAPI_ALM_COM_GETDET     I GET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS           Reading of Fields                                           .
IF_EX_IBAPI_ALM_OPR_GETDET     I GET_CUSTOMER_FIELDS           Reading of Fields                                           .
IF_EX_IBAPI_ALM_ORD_MODIFY     I MODIFY_INPUT_DATA             Changing Entry Data before the Inspection                   .
IF_EX_IBRT_GEN_ADD_IN          I CHANGE_INSTANCE_DATA          Influence Instance Data                                     .
IF_EX_IBSSI_RECEIVE_TO_UPL     I PREPARE_DATA_FOR_MDG          Set User Data in Container for the MDG                      .
IF_EX_IBSSI_RECEIVE_TO_UPL     I READ_AND_DELETE_FROM_BAPIMTCS Get and Delete User Data from BAPIMTCS                      .
IF_EX_IBSSI_SEND_TO_DWN        I FILL_BAPIMTCS                 Fill User Data Into BAPIMTCS                                .
IF_EX_IBS_FS_LIST_OPTIONS      I CHECK_FIELDLIST               Field List for Display in MiniApps as Template              .
IF_EX_IB_R3_BOMEXPNO_BADI      I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_BOMEXPNO_BADI      I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_BOM_BADI           I ECN_LIST2_SAVE                Call-Up of Save Module in CL_IBASE_R3_ECN_LIST2             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CHARACT_BADI       I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CHARACT_BADI       I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CLASSIF_BADI       I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CLASSIF_BADI       I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CLASS_BADI         I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CLASS_BADI         I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONFPROF_BADI      I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONFPROF_BADI      I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONSTRNET_BADI     I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONSTRNET_BADI     I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONSTR_BADI        I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_CONSTR_BADI        I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_DEPCY_BADI         I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_DEPCY_BADI         I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_FLOB_BADI          I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_FLOB_BADI          I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_LCHARACT_BADI      I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_LCHARACT_BADI      I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_LOCDEPCY_BADI      I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_LOCDEPCY_BADI      I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_TREE_CONX_MENU     I ADD_MENU_ENTRIES              Enhancement of Right-Mouse-Button-Menu                      .
IF_EX_IB_R3_TREE_CONX_MENU     I CONTEXT_MENU_REQUEST          Processing a Request Using Right-Mouse-Button-Menu          .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARFUN_BADI        I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARFUN_BADI        I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARTABC_BADI       I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARTABC_BADI       I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARTAB_BADI        I EXECUTE_DISPLAY               Executes display function on the object                     .
IF_EX_IB_R3_VARTAB_BADI        I INSERT_DISPLAY                Inserts Display Function in the IBase Tree Menu             .
IF_EX_ICH_KANBAN_MD            I AFTER_CONTACT_PERSON_FINDING  Extend Data for Contact Person                              .
IF_EX_ICH_KANBAN_MD            I BEFORE_CONVERSION             Change Control Cycle Data                                   .
IF_EX_ICH_KANBAN_MD            I BEFORE_FINAL_DECISION         Extend Log Outputs                                          .
IF_EX_ICH_KANBAN_MD            I BEFORE_TRANSMISSION           Extend Data Before Data Transfer                            .
IF_EX_ICH_OEM                  I CM_SOURCE_SELECT              Data extraction management for CM                           .
IF_EX_ICH_OEM                  I KEYFG_SELECT                  Select for Key Figure                                       .
IF_EX_ICH_OEM                  I OEM_SOURCE_SELECT             Data extraction management for OEM                          .
IF_EX_ICLE_BULKSUBRO           I MODIFY_REQUESTITEM            Change Receivable Items                                     .
IF_EX_ICLE_BULKSUBRO           I REQUESTITEM_ASSIGNED_PAYITEM  Provide Link Data for Payment Items                         .
IF_EX_ICLE_EVTSRCH             I FIELDCATALOG_MODIFY           Manipulate Field Catalog                                    .
IF_EX_ICLE_EVTSRCH             I FORBID                        Prevent Search with Prohibited Selection Conditions         .
IF_EX_ICLE_EVTSRCH             I HITLIST_FILTER                Filter Hit List                                             .
IF_EX_ICLE_FMOD2               I EVENT_FMOD2                   Determines Field Group Status at BDT Event FMOD2            .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I ADDRNUMBER_GET                Determine Address of Payee (Payment Method: Check)          .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I BANKID_GET                    Determine Payee's Bank Details                              .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I BULK_CHECK                    Verification from Bulk Payment                              .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I CHECK_NUMBER_VALIDATE         Verify Check Number                                         .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I CHECK_OPEN_AMOUNT_FOR_CLEARINGCheck Whether Open (Remaining) Items in CD same as OI in Clm.
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I CHECK_PAYMENT_PLAN            Create/Check Payment Plan Conditions                        .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I CHECK_REG_CALL                Call Check Register                                         .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I CHECK_VOID_CHECKPAYMENT       Provide Cancellation Reason for Check                       .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DETERMINE_BANKID_BANKACCOUNT  Find Bank and Account Number                                .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DISBURSEMENT                  Post Payments to Disbursement System                        .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DOCUMENT_CHECK                Check Whether Payment Has Already Been Cleared              .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DOCUMENT_CLEAR                Clear Open Items                                            .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DOCUMENT_DISPLAY              Display Dialog Box with Disbursement Data for Payment       .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I DOCUMENT_READ                 Read CD Document for Mini-CD Screen                         .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I GET_INS_OBJ                   Determine Insurance Object                                  .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I GET_PAYOPTIONKEY              Get Payment Option Key                                      .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I GET_POLICY_REF                Read References for Policy in Collections/Disbursements     .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I INVOICE_PAYMETHOD_GET         Invoice: Determine Payment Method for Payee                 .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I ONLINE_CHECK_PRINT            Print Online Check                                          .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I PAYMENT_METHOD_GET            Input Help for Payment Method Toolbar                       .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I PERIOD_DETERMINE              Date Calculation Dependent on Payment Plan                  .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I RECEIVED_AMOUNT_READ          Read All Claim-Relevant Receipts from Collections System    .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I RECEIVED_ENTRY_DELETE         Delete Entries of Claim-Relevant Receipts                   .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I REVERSE_CLEARING_DOC          Reset Clearing                                              .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SCHED_POS_COMPRESS            Compress Scheduling Items                                   .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SCHED_POS_GETPAYPLAN_ALL      Get All Payment Plans for a Claim                           .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SCHED_POS_MODIFY              Adjust Default Values for Documents                         .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SCHED_POS_MOD_CLEAR           Change Default Fields in Clearing Document                  .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SCHED_POS_SIMULATION_ALL      Simulate All Payment Plans for a Claim                      .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SET_CUSTOM_VALUE              Transfer Freely Definable Value to Instance                 .
IF_EX_ICLF_CD                  I SINGLE_DOCUMENT_DISPLAY       Display Single Document                                     .
IF_EX_ICLF_OPEN_ITEMS          I GET_OPEN_ITEMS                Determines Open Items of Current Contract                   .
IF_EX_ICLH_ADD_PAY_DAY_DET     I DETERMINE_DAYS                Determines Number of Copayment Days                         .
IF_EX_ICLH_DRG_GROUPER         I CALL_GROUPER                  Call External Grouper System                                .
IF_EX_ICLN_DUP_CHECK_BP        I ICLN_DUP_CHECK_BP             Checks for Duplicate Entries of Business Partners           .
IF_EX_ICLN_DUP_CHECK_RE        I ICLN_DUP_CHECK_RE             Error Message if Business Partner Exists in Duplicate       .
IF_EX_ICLN_FNOL_PREFILL        I SET_DEFAULTS                  Set Defaults                                                .
IF_EX_ICLN_FNOL_VALIDATE       I VALIDATE_ADDRESS              Validates Postal Code                                       .
IF_EX_ICLN_FNOL_VALIDATE       I VALIDATE_FNOL                 Validates FNOL Data                                         .
IF_EX_ICLN_SUBCL_DET           I ICLN_FNOL_SUBCL_DET           Defines Subclaim Type for Conversion of FNOL to Claim       .
IF_EX_ICL_ACTIVITY_MGMNT       I DETERMINE_DUETIME             Overrules Due Date Calculation in Claim                     .
IF_EX_ICL_ACTIVITY_MGMNT       I MODIFY_TICL044                Redefines Task Definition in Claim                          .
IF_EX_ICL_ACTIVITY_MGMNT       I MODIFY_TICL950                Redefines Task Definition in Claim Bundle                   .
IF_EX_ICL_ACTIVITY_MGMNT       I NOTIFY                        A Change Has Occurred in Activity Management (Claim)        .
IF_EX_ICL_ACTIVITY_MGMNT       I NOTIFY_BUNDLE                 A Change Has Occurred in Activity Management (Claim Bundle) .
IF_EX_ICL_ACT_PRIO_MAP         I CONVERT_FOR_CLAIM             Converts Old Priority to New Priority for Task in Claim     .
IF_EX_ICL_ACT_PRIO_MAP         I CONVERT_FOR_CLAIM_BUNDLE      Converts Old Priority to New Priority f. Task in Claim Bndle.
IF_EX_ICL_ADD_ACCOUNTING       I GET_BAPI_ACCNT_FLDS_NEW_EXIST Has New Method Been Implemented (X = Yes)                   .
IF_EX_ICL_ADD_ACCOUNTING       I GET_BAPI_ACCOUNTING_FIELDS    Fill Additional Customer-Specific Acct Assgnmt Flds in BAPI .
IF_EX_ICL_ADD_ACCOUNTING       I GET_BAPI_ACCOUNTING_FIELDS_NEWFill Additional Customer-Specific Acct Assgnmt Flds in BAPI .
IF_EX_ICL_ADD_ACCOUNTING       I GET_RES_ACCOUNTING_FIELDS     Determine Additional Customer-Specific Acct Assgnmnt Fields .
IF_EX_ICL_ALV_EXCLFUNC         I CHANGE                        Change Exclusion of Functions                               .
IF_EX_ICL_BBP_PO_CREATE        I DATA_TRANSFER_BBP2CLAIM       Transfer of Data From BAPI to Claims Management System      .
IF_EX_ICL_BBP_PO_CREATE        I DATA_TRANSFER_CLAIM2BBP       Transfer of Data from Claims Management System to BAPI      .
IF_EX_ICL_BBP_PO_CREATE        I PO_CREATE                     Creation of Purchase Oder in External Procurement System    .
IF_EX_ICL_BBP_PO_CREATE        I PO_GET_DETAIL                 Determination of Details Regarding Order                    .
IF_EX_ICL_BBP_PO_CREATE        I SRM_BP_GET                    Get User Data of Business Partner From SRM System           .
IF_EX_ICL_BENEFITSPLIT         I CHECK_PRIVLG                  Check Special Rights                                        .
IF_EX_ICL_BP_FULL_MAINTENA     I CALL_BP_FULL_MAINTENANCE      Call Business Partner Full Maintenance                      .
IF_EX_ICL_BRF                  I MODIFY_CONTEXT                Change Context CS_ACTUAL in Event IV_EVENT                  .
IF_EX_ICL_BRF_CONTEXT          I CHANGE_CONTEXT                Allows Change to BRF Context (ICL_ACTUAL)                   .
IF_EX_ICL_BUNDLE_SEARCH        I GET                           Search for Matching Claim Bundles                           .
IF_EX_ICL_CAREREP              I DATEN_AUFBEREITEN             Format Data                                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_CAREREP              I DATEN_EXPORTIEREN             Export data                                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_CAREREP              I DATEN_GEAENDERT               Data Has Changed                                            .
IF_EX_ICL_CATALOGS             I CATALOG_TO_ITEM               Convert Catalog Items to Claim Items                        .
IF_EX_ICL_CATALOGS             I DETERMINE_CATALOG             Determine Catalog to Be Used                                .
IF_EX_ICL_CATALOGS             I DETERMINE_PARAM_LIST          Determine Parameter List for Calling Catalog System         .
IF_EX_ICL_CCALC_BENTYPE_EV     I CURR_BENTYPE_CALC             Calculate Current Benefit Type                              .
IF_EX_ICL_CCALC_LIMDED_MOD     I MODIFY_DED                    Changes Deductible                                          .
IF_EX_ICL_CCALC_LIMDED_MOD     I MODIFY_LIMIT                  Changes Deductible                                          .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIMASSIGN          I GET_ASSIGN_GUID               Determine UUID of Claim Subobject                           .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIMASSIGN          I GET_ASSIGN_REFOBJ             Determine Referenced Claim Subobject of a Claim             .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIMASSIGN          I GET_TABNAME                   Determine Table Name of Claim Subobject                     .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIMASSIGN          I SET_ASSIGN_GUID               Set UUID of Claim Subobject                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIMNO_GET          I CLAIMNO_GET                   Determine Claim Number                                      .
IF_EX_ICL_CLAIM_OTHER_READ     I OTHER_CLAIMS_READ             Read Claim Headers from Other Claims                        .
IF_EX_ICL_CLINIC_SEL           I FIND_CLINIC                   Hospital Selection for Request for Inpatient Rehabilitation .
IF_EX_ICL_CLSRCH               I FIELDCATALOG_MODIFY           Manipulate Field Catalog                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_CLSRCH               I FORBID                        Prevent Search with Prohibited Selection Conditions         .
IF_EX_ICL_CLSRCH               I HITLIST_FILTER                Filter Hit List                                             .
IF_EX_ICL_CLTYPE_MAPPING       I MAP_LOSSTYPE                  Find New Loss Type from Old Loss Type                       .
IF_EX_ICL_COMPCODE_CURR        I GET_CURRENCY                  Determine Currency from Company Code                        .
IF_EX_ICL_CORR_ADDRESSEE       I GET_DEFAULT_ADDRESSEE         Determine Standard Correspondence Recipient                 .
IF_EX_ICL_COVERAGE             I FILL_DESCRIP_EXT              Fill field DESCRIP_EXT in structure ICL_COVTYPE_RESLIM      .
IF_EX_ICL_CURR_SELECT_SOBJ     I GET_CURRENT_SUBOBJ            Get Current Claim Subobject                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_BENSTRUCT       I BENNODE_DISP_GET              Information for Display of Node of Benefit Type Tree        .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_ITEMLIST        I BENTYPE_ATTRIBS               Gets Attributes of Benefit Types                            .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_ITEMLIST        I BENTYPE_SHLP_ENTRIES          Gets Entries for Search Help of Benefit Types               .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_ITEMLIST        I BUILD_ITEM_TREE               Creates Graphic Benefit Type Tree                           .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_ITEMLIST        I ITEM_TYPES                    Gets Permitted Claim Item Types                             .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_ITEMLIST        I POV_BENTYPE                   Popup for Value Help for Benefit Type                       .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_LIMDED          I BENNODE_LIMATTRIB_GET         Gets Attributes on Which Limit Calculate Depends            .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_LIMDED          I POLLMDD_EVAL_SINGLE           Gets Limit and Deductible from Policy                       .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_RESERVE         I PAYI_BENTYPE_ATTRIBS          Gets Attributes of Benefit Type                             .
IF_EX_ICL_CUST_RESERVE         I RESERVE_TYPE_PAYI             Gets Reserve Type for an ICLPAYI Record                     .
IF_EX_ICL_CVERM_TABLE          I COPY_AND_TRANSPORT            Copy and Transport Child Table                              .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICLC48_FCODE                  Process Additional Data for Subobject in FCODE              .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICLC48_PBC                    Additional Fields in Item Overview in Single Invoice        .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICLH63_ADJUST_AMOUNTS         Amount Adjustment in Differences Log                        .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICLI91_ITEM_PBC               Additional Fields in Items in Single Invoice                .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICLI91_PBC                    Additional Fields in Single Invoice Overview in Coll.Inv.   .
IF_EX_ICL_DIFF                 I ICL_CATEGORY_HELP             Select Text Categories                                      .
IF_EX_ICL_DIPL                 I CHECK_ALL                     Check All Distribution Plans and Items                      .
IF_EX_ICL_DIPL                 I CHECK_DIPL                    Check Distribution Plans                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_DIPL                 I CHECK_DIPLIT                  Check Distribution Plan Items                               .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_AGENT_MAN_CM           Assign Agent Manually to a Claim                            .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_AGENT_MAN_SC           Assign Agent Manually to a Subclaim                         .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_AC          Assign Dispatcher Automatically to an Activity              .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_CM          Assign Dispatcher Automatically to a Claim                  .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_MAN_CM      Assign Dispatcher Manually to a Claim                       .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_MAN_SC      Assign Dispatcher Manually to a Subclaim                    .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_PY          Assign Dispatcher to a Payment                              .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I ASSIGN_DISPATCHER_SC          Assign Dispatcher to a Subclaim                             .
IF_EX_ICL_DSPTCHR_ASSMNT       I GET_DISPATCHERS_AGENTS        Provides Dispatcher with Available Claim Handler            .
IF_EX_ICL_DUPLICATE_CHECK      I GET_ENTRY                     Execute Search for Duplicates (Initial Screen)              .
IF_EX_ICL_DUPLICATE_CHECK      I GET_SAVE                      Execute Search for Duplicates (BDT Event DCHCK)             .
IF_EX_ICL_DUPLICATE_CHECK      I HITLIST_PREPARE               Prepare Hit List                                            .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR                  I DETERMINE_EBRP                Determine External Bill Reviewer                            .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR                  I INBOUND_FEES                  Charges                                                     .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR                  I INBOUND_INVOICE               Inbound Invoice                                             .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR                  I OUTBOUND_INVOICE              Outbound Invoice                                            .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR_IB               I DATA_ENHANCEMENT              Enhance Data                                                .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR_IB               I DATA_VALIDATION               Validate Data                                               .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR_OB               I DATA_ENHANCEMENT              Enhance Data                                                .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR_OB               I DATA_VALIDATION               Validate Data                                               .
IF_EX_ICL_EBR_UI               I DETERMINE_EBRP                Determine External Bill Reviewer                            .
IF_EX_ICL_ESTIMAT_SYSTEM       I ESTIMATION_SYSTEM_CALL        Call External Evaluation System                             .
IF_EX_ICL_EXTENDED_CHECK       I CHANGE_OBJECT_LIST            Change Quantity of Claim Subobjects to Be Checked           .
IF_EX_ICL_EXTENDED_CHECK       I CHECK_OBJECT                  Call Own BRF Events for Checking Objects                    .
IF_EX_ICL_EXTENDED_CHECK       I GET_SUBOBJECT                 Determine Possible Claim Subobjects for Parameter           .
IF_EX_ICL_EXT_POL_IMPORT       I CHECK_EXT_POL_EXISTS          Checks Whether Policy Exists in External System             .
IF_EX_ICL_EXT_POL_IMPORT       I FILL_ACORD_POL                Fills ACORD Structure with Policy Information               .
IF_EX_ICL_EXT_POL_IMPORT       I FILL_ADDCL_POL                Provides Additional Clauses of Policy                       .
IF_EX_ICL_EXT_POL_IMPORT       I READ_ADDCL_FREETEXT           Reads Free Text from Additional Clauses                     .
IF_EX_ICL_FMOD2                I EVENT_FMOD2                   Other FMOD2 for Field Groups acc. to Standard FMOD2         .
IF_EX_ICL_HI_CHECKKEY_GET      I GET_CHECKKEY                  Get Table Check Key of External Key Table                   .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I DISTRIBUTE                    Distribution of (Default) Values (Particularly Quantities)  .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I EXTRAPOLITE_CURRENTLEVEL      Current Knowledge Status                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I EXTRAPOLITE_LASTYEAR          Captured in Previous Year                                   .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I MANUAL_CLAIMRES               Manual Claim Reserve by Clerk (Particularly Quantities)     .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I MANUAL_IBNRRES                Manual Default Values by Controller (Partic.Cases/Quantity) .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I OTHER_CALCULATION             Unspecified Calculation Method of IBNR Reserve              .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I PROCESS_DRIVERS               Driver Data Processing                                      .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I PROCESS_MAIN                  Main Data Processing                                        .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I STAT_CLAIMRES                 Open Quantities /Sta. Average Values (for Claim Reserve)    .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I STAT_IBNRRES                  Statistical Average Values (for IBNR)                       .
IF_EX_ICL_IBNR_CALCULATE       I SUM_OF_DETAIL                 Simple Sum of Single Reserves                               .
IF_EX_ICL_IDOC                 I CUSTOM_CLAIM_DI_PROCESSING    Enhance Structure of FM ICL_CLAIM_DI                        .
IF_EX_ICL_IDOC                 I CUSTOM_SEGMENT                Enhance IDoc Categories                                     .
IF_EX_ICL_INSURED_OBJECT       I IOBJ_DELETE                   Delete Entries for Insured Object                           .
IF_EX_ICL_INSURED_OBJECT       I IOBJ_DESCRIPTION_GET          Get the description on an insured object                    .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I APPR2INV                      Change Invoice Item After Transfer from BenDecisn (ExpMode) .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DI                    CollInv: Adjust Single Inv: Participants and Invoice Date   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DISCOUNT_POPUP        CollInv: Discount Amt in Popup                              .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DI_PREPARE            CollInv: Adjust Single Inv: Create Generic DI Table         .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DUMMYCLAIM_CHANGE_DI  CollInv: Call DI for Change to Posting or Dummy Claim       .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DUMMYCLAIM_CREATE_DI  CollInv: Call DI for Creation of Posting or Dummy Claim     .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_DUPLICATE_CHECK       Collective Inv: Check for Duplicates when Creating/Changing .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_INVOICE_CHANGED       CollInv: Single Invoice Changed                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_INVOICE_PAYMENT_CHANGECollInv: Tools Mask: Create DI Input                        .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_PAYMENTLEVEL_DEFAULT  CollInv: Prefilled for Payment Level when Creating CollInv  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_PAYMENT_ITEM_MODIFY   CollInv: Payout of All Invoices: New Items                  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_PAYMENT_STATUS_CHECK  CollInv: Payout of All Invoices: Status of Invoices         .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_SAVE_POPUP_DEFAULT    CollInv: Prefilled for Payment Level when Creating CollInv  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_TOOL_ALV_CREATE       CollInv: Tools Mask: Creation of Internal ALV Table         .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_TOOL_DI               CollInv: Tools Mask: Transfer Single Invoices via DI        .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I BULKINV_TOOL_DI_CREATE        CollInv: Tools Mask: Transfer Single Invoices via DI        .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I CLAIM_CREATE_N_CHANGE         Create Claim in Background and then Process                 .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I CLAIM_DETERMINE               Determine Claim with Invoice Mass Entry                     .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I CLAIM_HANDLER_DETERMINE       Determine Clerk with Invoice Mass Entry                     .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I DLVE1                         BDT Event DLVE1                                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I GET_PARTNERS_FROM_BULKINV     Control Copying of Participants in Collective/Single Invoice.
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INIT_DISPLAY_PERIOD           Set Initial Period for Display Period                       .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVNOT01_DI_CLAIM_CREATE      Invoice Initial Screen: Create New Claim via DI             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_BULKINV_CHANGE_DI     Change Collective Invoice from Single Invoice               .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_BULKINV_CREATE_DI     Create Collective Invoice from Single Invoice               .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_BULKINV_XCHANGE       Determine Whether Change of CollInv from Single Inv Needed  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_CHECK_BEFORE_PAYMENT  Check Invoice Before Creating Payments                      .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_FROM_APPROVAL_GET     Transfer of Benefit Decision Item to InvoiceItm             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_FROM_APPROVAL_MODIFY  Change BenDecsnItm Before DI and Crtn of InvItm             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_INVPOS_SUPPLEMENT     Change Additional Information for each Invoice Item         .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_ITEM_CHANGE           Change Current Invoice Item in PAI (e.g. Own Contribution)  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_ITEM_CHECK            Check Invoice Item During Entry                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_ITEM_CREATE           Change to InvItem for Creation During FCODE Processing      .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_ITEM_TOOL_CHANGE      Change Invoice Item through Tool Action                     .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_PAYMENT_ENHANCE       Enhance Invoice Clearing                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_REFUND                Credit Note: Change Receivable (Payt) Header and Item       .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_REQUEST_ITEM_CHANGE   Receivable: Change New Receivable Item                      .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_REQUEST_ITEM_SELECT   Check Invoice and Payment Amounts for Subsequent Claim      .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_REQUEST_PAYSUGGEST    Subsequent Claim: Creation of and Navigation to Payt Proposl.
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_TRANSFER              Transfer Clm Itm Grp: Invoice Entry -" Invoice Processing   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I INVOICE_TRANSFER_CHECK_PRICE  Invoice Entry -" Invoice Processing (Compare Catalog Price) .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I ITEM_CONTRIBAMOUNT_CHANGE     Modify Own Contribution at Item Level                       .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I LOSSTYPE_DETERMINE            CollInv: Selection Incident Type with Non-Unique Cust.      .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_DI_CLAIM              CollInv:MassProc: Read Mass Invoice via DI: Claim No. Known .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_DI_POLICY             CollInv:MassProc: Read Mass Invoice via DI: Policy Known    .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_DI_POLPROD            CollInv:MassProc: Read Mass Invoice via DI: PolProd Known   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHANGE_ICLI80    CollInv:MassProc: Change Entry for InvItm from View ICLI80  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHANGE_ICLI82    CollInv:MassProc: Change Entry for InvItm from View ICLI82  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHANGE_ICLI83    CollInv:MassProc: Change Entry for InvItm from View ICLI83  .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHECK_ICLI80     CollInv:MassProc: Check Entry for InvItm from View ICLI80   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHECK_ICLI82     CollInv:MassProc: Check Entry for InvItm from View ICLI82   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_CHECK_ICLI83     CollInv:MassProc: Check Entry for InvItm from View ICLI83   .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I MASSINV_ITEM_SUM              CollInv: Mass Procsng: Change Net Itm Sum Before NetTotalChk.
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I PAI                           PAI Processing for View ICLHxxx                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I PAYSUGGEST_ITEM_SPLIT         Split Payment Proposal Items                                .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I PBC                           PBC Processing for View ICLHxxx                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I PBO                           PBO Processing for View ICLHxxx                             .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I POLICY_DETERMINE              Determine Contract in Invoice Mass Entry                    .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I PRESCRIPTION_DETERMINE        Collective Inv: SelectPrescription (InvMassEntry)           .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I REASSIGN                      Reassign Invoice                                            .
IF_EX_ICL_INVOICE              I SUBCLTYPE_DETERMINE           CollInv: Selection Incident Type with Non-Unique Cust.      .
IF_EX_ICL_ITEM                 I AFTER_COPY                    After Claim Item Has Been Copied (Multiple Prescription)    .
IF_EX_ICL_ITEM                 I MODIFIED                      After Claim Item Has Been Created, Changed, or Deleted      .
IF_EX_ICL_LITIGATION           I CHECK_LITHEADER               Check Litigation (Header)                                   .
IF_EX_ICL_LITIGATION           I CHECK_LITITEM                 Check Litigation Step                                       .
IF_EX_ICL_LOSS_ALLOCATION      I COMPENSATION_CALCULATION      Compensation Calculation on Basis of Loss Allocatn Agreement.
IF_EX_ICL_LOSS_ALLOCATION      I GET_LIAB_RATE                 Gets Liability Rate of Partner from Loss Allocation Agreemnt.
IF_EX_ICL_NAVNODE_SUBOBJ       I GET_SUBOBJECTS                Display List of Current Claim Subobjects of Node            .
IF_EX_ICL_NAVTREE_NODE         I GET_NODE_TEXT                 Specify Node Text and Icon                                  .
IF_EX_ICL_NEGOTIATION          I CHECK_ARGITEM                 Check Argument                                              .
IF_EX_ICL_NEGOTIATION          I CHECK_NEGHEADER               Check Negotiation (Header)                                  .
IF_EX_ICL_NEGOTIATION          I CHECK_NEGITEM                 Check Offer/Demand                                          .
IF_EX_ICL_OI                   I SELECT_TEMPLATES              Context-Dependent Definition of Templates Offered           .
IF_EX_ICL_OTHER_COVERAGE       I ALLOWED_RCOVTYPES             Provides the list of allowed other coverage type            .
IF_EX_ICL_OTHER_COVERAGE       I CHECK_RCOVTYPE                Used in the PAI check of the item                           .
IF_EX_ICL_OTHER_COVERAGE       I RCOVTYPE_REQUIRED             Additional coverage type is required for this item?         .
IF_EX_ICL_OUTBOX_BUNDLE        I DETERMINE_OUTBOX_BUNDLE       Determination of Outgoing Post Bundle Number                .
IF_EX_ICL_PART_OCCURENCE_TEXT  I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Texts of Participant Occurrence                      .
IF_EX_ICL_PART_OCCURENCE_TEXT  I SET_TITLE                     Sets Heading for Comment Column                             .
IF_EX_ICL_PAYMENT              I ADD_NODE                      Adjust Node in Tree                                         .
IF_EX_ICL_PAYMENT              I CHANGE_FIELDCAT               Change ALV Field Catalog                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_PAYMENT              I TREE_INIT                     Initialization of ALV Tree                                  .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_NEW_SC_DATA      I GET_ALL_COVTYPES              Import from Policy System                                   .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I CALL_TRANSACTION              Call Policy Transaction in Policy Management System         .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I CHECK_POLICY_EXISTS           Checks Whether Policy Exists                                .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I HLPVAL_BY_BPARTNER            Determination of Policy Data for a Policyholder             .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I HLPVAL_BY_PLATENO             Determination of Policy Data for a License Plate            .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I HLPVAL_BY_POLEX               Determination of Policy Data for an External Policy         .
IF_EX_ICL_PMI_PROXY            I POLICY_LOAD                   Load Policy Into Policy Snapshot                            .
IF_EX_ICL_POLICY_DISPLAY       I CALL_TRANSACTION              Call Policy Transaction in Policy Management System         .
IF_EX_ICL_POLICY_POV           I POV_POLICY                    Popup on Input Help for Contract Number                     .
IF_EX_ICL_POLICY_POV           I POV_POLICY_POLICY             Popup on Input Help for Policy Number                       .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I AFTER_POLICY_LOAD             Called After POLICY_LOAD                                    .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I CHECK_POLICY_EXISTS           Checks whether a policy exists; returns policy type         .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I CHECK_SKIP_PREMCHECK          Checks whether premium check should be skipped              .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I CHK_POLICY_BEN_EXCL_PER       Check for Benefit Exclusion Period or No-Liability          .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I GET_OUTSTANDING_PREMIUMS      Gets the outstanding premiums for the policy                .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I LAST_CHANGED_EFF_BEFORE       Returns Date of Last Policy Amendment                       .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I POLICY_INFORMATION_GET        Gets information on policy for purpose of policy matching   .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I POLICY_LOAD                   Load policy into policy snapshot                            .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I POLSEARCH_BY_BUSPARTNER       Search for related policies of given business partner       .
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I POLSEARCH_BY_PLATE_NUMBER     Search for policy by license plate number of insured vehicle.
IF_EX_ICL_POLS_IMPORT_POLS     I TEST_ADDITION                 Test                                                        .
IF_EX_ICL_POSTDATE_FILL        I GET_POSTDATE                  Gets Posting Date                                           .
IF_EX_ICL_PREV_CLAIMS          I GET_CLAIM_HIST                Determine Claim History                                     .
IF_EX_ICL_PROCURE              I AFTER_COPY                    Copy of a Claim Item Grouping                               .
IF_EX_ICL_PROCURE              I MODIFIED                      Creation, Change, Deletion of Claim Item Grouping           .
IF_EX_ICL_PROC_AUTH_CHECK      I PROCUREMENT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   Execute Authorization Check                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_QC_ALLOWED           I CHECK                         Change and Display Possible in Quick Claim Mode?            .
IF_EX_ICL_RBP_SRCH             I PERFORMER_GET_EARLY           Automatic Performer Assignment: Early Search                .
IF_EX_ICL_RBP_SRCH             I PERFORMER_GET_LATE            Automatic Performer Assignment: Later Search                .
IF_EX_ICL_RBP_SRCH             I PERFORMER_GET_MANUAL          Automatic Performer Assignment: Manual                      .
IF_EX_ICL_RIDATA               I SEND_TO_RI                    Trigger Data Transfer to Reinsurance System                 .
IF_EX_ICL_RIDATA               I SET_RIDATA                    Format Data for Reinsurance                                 .
IF_EX_ICL_STACKHANDLE          I APPEND_DI_STACK               Enhance Specific Lot to Include Specified Data              .
IF_EX_ICL_STACKHANDLE          I CHECK_SUBOBJECT_EXIST         Check Whether Claim Subobject of Another Claim Exists       .
IF_EX_ICL_STACKHANDLE          I PROVIDE_EXISTING_SUBOBJECT    Determine Claim Subobject ID                                .
IF_EX_ICL_SUBOBJECT_SERVICE    I BUILD_SUBOBJECT               Sets Up Field SUBOBJECT for the Object                      .
IF_EX_ICL_SUBOBJECT_SERVICE    I GET_SUBOBJECTS                Provides All Subobjects that Are "Below" the Object         .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I TAXCODE_F4                    Display Selection List for Tax on Sales/Purchases Code      .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I TAX_CALC_POPUP                Calculate Value-Added Tax for an Amount                     .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I TAX_NET_CALCULATE             Calculation of Net Tax Value for an Amount                  .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I TAX_SPREADSHEET_GET           Get Tax Procedure                                           .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I TXJCD_F4                      Adjust Selection of Tax Code to Location                    .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I VALUE_ADDED_TAX_CHECK         Execute Plausibility Checks for Value-Added Tax             .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_01               I VALUE_ADDED_TAX_DMINE         Calculation of Value-Added Tax for a Location               .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_ITEM             I ADD_TAX_RPTABLE               Determines Additional Reportable Items                      .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_ITEM             I BPTIN_CHK                     Checks Tax ID Number of Business Partner                    .
IF_EX_ICL_TAX_ITEM             I WTHHD_PYMT_ITEM               Determines Withholding Tax of Payment Item                  .
IF_EX_ICL_USER_GROUP           I GET_USER_GROUP_PART           Delivers Entries on User Group                              .
IF_EX_ICL_WCOMP                I CALC_DFLT_PAYPLAN             Determines Payment Methd + No.of Working Days f.Repet.Payt  .
IF_EX_ICL_WCOMP                I CALC_LEFTOVR_PAYMENT          Determines Surplus Days, Total Amount f.Surplus, Amt per Day.
IF_EX_ICL_WCOMP                I CALC_PAYMENT_AMT              Determines Payment Amount                                   .
IF_EX_ICL_WCOMP                I COMPARE_AGAINST_PROPOSED      Compares Value Input by User with System Default Value      .
IF_EX_ICL_WCOMP                I COMPARE_AMT_AGAINST_MINMAX    Compares Compensation Amount with Min./Max. Amount          .
IF_EX_ICL_WF_CONTAINER         I CONTAINER_MODIFY              Modify Event Container                                      .
IF_EX_ICL_WF_EVT_CONTAINER     I CONTAINER_MODIFY              Modify Event Container                                      .
IF_EX_IDCFMFLOWCALC            I CALCULATE_FLOWS               Execute calculations and fill flow tables                   .
IF_EX_IDCFMFLOWCALC            I GET_PERCENTAGE                Determine percentage with conditions                        .
IF_EX_IDCFM_ACCIF_TRAC         I ADD_TAX_INFO                  Tax information preparation                                 .
IF_EX_IDCFM_ACCIF_TRAC         I GET_RELATED_DOCUMENT          Get reference to posted document                            .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_01                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 01   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_02                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 02   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_03                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 03   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_04                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 04   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_05                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 05   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_06                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 06   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_07                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 07   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_08                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 08   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_09                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 09   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_10                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 10   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_11                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 11   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_12                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 12   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_13                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 13   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_14                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 14   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_15                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 15   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_16                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 16   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_17                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 17   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS                I MODIFY_18                     Modify Records for China Golden Audit Report/Data File 18   .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS_04             I GET_BOOKKEEPER                GET BOOKKEEPER NAME                                         .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS_04             I GET_CASHIER                   GET CASHIER                                                 .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS_04             I GET_DOUBLECHECKSTAFF          GET DOUBLE CHECK STAFF NAME                                 .
IF_EX_IDCN_GAIS_10             I VALIDATE                      Validation for result of report 10                          .
IF_EX_IDCO_BPL_CHECK_BWKEY     I CHECK_BWKEY                   Method to Check if ML active in a Valuation area            .
IF_EX_IDCO_BPL_CHECK_BWKEY     I CHECK_SCC_ACTIVE              Method to Check if SCC active in a Valuation area           .
IF_EX_IDCO_BPL_RCKM_MR21       I CHECK_UPDATE_OBEW             Method Checks entries & Updates OBEW table during MR21      .
IF_EX_IDCO_BPL_RCKM_MR21       I LEAVE_PROGRAM                 Method to control leave program from MR21                   .
IF_EX_IDCO_SCC_PRICES_CHNG     I EXCLUDE_FROM_PRICECHANGE      No Price Changes in MM or FI                                .
IF_EX_IDCO_SCC_PRICES_CHNG     I OBEW_NO_GL_POSTING            No Price Changes in FI                                      .
IF_EX_IDOC_COPY_MANAGE         I CHANGE_IDOC_INFO              Modification of Control and Data Record                     .
IF_EX_IDOC_CREATION_CHECK      I IDOC_DATA_CHECK               Check IDoc Data to see Whether an IDoc is Generated         .
IF_EX_IDOC_DATA_INSERT         I FILL                          Get Segments to Be Inserted                                 .
IF_EX_IDOC_DATA_MAPPER         I PROCESS                       Provide Data for Mapping                                    .
IF_EX_IDOC_XML_ENVELOPE_IN     I PROCESS                       Method for Removing Envelope                                .
IF_EX_IDOC_XML_ENVELOPE_OU     I PROCESS                       Method for Creating Envelope                                .
IF_EX_IDPUR_BPL_GET_SCHEMA     I GET_CHARGEABLE_SCHEMA         Method to get chargeable schema for chargeable into record  .
IF_EX_IDUS99C_01               I MODIFY_AFTER_SELECTION        Modify internal table after the selection has been completed.
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I ADDINFO_ENTER_BEFORE_SELECTIONenable the user to enter additional selection parameters    .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I ALLDATA_MODIFY_BEFORE_OUTPUT  modify the w/tax data before output                         .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I ALL_DME_FIELDS_MODIFY         modify all DME contents                                     .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I DS_GET_DB_FILTER_ON_CALLBACK  Filtering function at event GET with callback routine       .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I MODIFY_DMEE                   Modification of DMEE's before output                        .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I MODIFY_FIELDCATALOG           modification of the ALV field catelog                       .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I QSTRMAIN_MODIFY_BEFORE_OUTPUT change the selected FI document line items                  .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I SCREEN_CHECKS_AFTER_INPUT     check sreen input.                                          .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I SET_FLAG_USE_ADD_SELECTION    set active additional selection                             .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADDFUNCINT       I UPDATES_AFTER_OUTPUT          change specific tables after output of report               .
IF_EX_IDWTREP_ADOBEPRINT       I PREPARE_ADOBE_PRINT           Prepare the selected data for the Adobe form print          .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_CHECK           I EVENT_CONSISTENCY_CHECK       Consistency Check of an Event                               .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_CHECK           I WORKAREA_SET_PROPOSAL         Set Default Data in Detail Screen                           .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_CHECK           I WORKLIST_CONSISTENCY_CHECK    Consistency Check of Interim Status                         .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I CHECK_NOTIF                   Check Notification (Existence/Notification Type)            .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I GOODS_MOVEMENT                Goods movement                                              .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I GOODS_MVMNT_ACTIVE_CHK        Implementation for Goods Movement Active?                   .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I NOTIF_HANDLING                Process Messages                                            .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I NOTIF_SELECTION               Select notifications                                        .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I READ_NOTIF_CUST               Read Customizing for Installation/Dismantling Notification  .
IF_EX_IEQCM_BE_DECOUPLING      I STRUCTUR_GAP_HANDLING         Process Structure Gaps                                      .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I CREATE_HOLE                   Create Structure Gap                                        .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I DELETE_HOLE                   Delete Structure Gap                                        .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Buffer Tables                                    .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I SELECT_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL       Determine Structure Gap to be Deleted                       .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I UPDATE_DB                     Update Database                                             .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I UPDATE_FID_EQUI               Compare and Update Function Identifier of Equipment or Gap  .
IF_EX_IEQCM_CCM_HOLE_BADI      I UPDATE_HOLE_FOR_INSTALL       Update Generated Structure Gap During Replacement           .
IF_EX_IEQCM_GOODS_MOVEMENT     I GOODS_MVMNT_UPD               Complete or Change Data for Goods Movement                  .
IF_EX_IEQCM_NOTIF_BADI         I CREATE                        Create Notification                                         .
IF_EX_IEQCM_NOTIF_BADI         I DELETE                        Delete Message                                              .
IF_EX_IEQCM_NOTIF_BADI         I FILL_CUST_DATA                Change Customer-Specific Data in Notification               .
IF_EX_IEQCM_NOTIF_BADI         I MODIFY                        Change Notification                                         .
IF_EX_IEQCM_NOTIF_BADI         I SELECT                        Select notifications                                        .
IF_EX_IEQCM_TRX_EXECUTABLE     I TRX_EXECUTABLE_CHECK          Check Whether Equipment History Can Be Changed              .
IF_EX_IERI_DIALOG_CHECK        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_PAI          Customer PAI Logic                                          .
IF_EX_IERI_DIALOG_CHECK        I PROCESS_CUSTOMER_PBO          Customer PBO Logic                                          .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMOV_SAVE     I ACTIONS_AFTER_INSTALL         Actions after installation (database update)                .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMOV_SAVE     I ACTIONS_AFTER_REMOVE          Actions after removal (database update)                     .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMOV_SAVE     I ACTIONS_BEFORE_INSTALL        Actions before installation (database update)               .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMOV_SAVE     I ACTIONS_BEFORE_REMOVE         Actions before removal (database update)                    .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMO_CHECK     I CHECK_AT_DISMANTLE            Performs all checks at removal                              .
IF_EX_IERI_INST_REMO_CHECK     I CHECK_AT_INSTALL              Performs all checks at installation                         .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I ADJUST_MESSAGETYPE            IS-specific check if message severity can be customized     .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I BEFORE_POSTING                IS changes to data before starting install / remove process .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I CONVERT_TIME                  Convert time and date into another time zone                .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I GET_TZONE_INTO                Get time zone into which time has to be converted           .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I IPW5_MESSAGE_HANDLING         Message handling in FU IPW5                                 .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I IPW5_SETUP_LOGS               Fill application log                                        .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I IS_ACTIONS_BEFORE_BOTH        IS specific program part for unforced fit                   .
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I SWITCH_SERNR_CHECK            IS-specific error handling after serial number --" full equi.
IF_EX_IERI_IPW4_INTERNAL1      I UPDATE_RESERVATION            IS specific updates to reservation before DB read           .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_INSTALL      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data from the screen                              .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_INSTALL      I ISU_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport data from the screen for ISU subscreen            .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_INSTALL      I ISU_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport data to the screen for ISU subscreen              .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_INSTALL      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data to the screen                                .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_REMOVAL      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data from the screen                              .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_REMOVAL      I ISU_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport data from the screen for ISU subscreen            .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_REMOVAL      I ISU_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport data to the screen for ISU subscreen              .
IF_EX_IERI_IS_ADD_REMOVAL      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data to the screen                                .
IF_EX_IERI_I_NOTIF_CUST        I CUS_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport of Data from Screen to Customer Screen            .
IF_EX_IERI_I_NOTIF_CUST        I CUS_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport of Data from Customer Screen to Screen            .
IF_EX_IERI_I_NOTIF_CUST        I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport of Data from Screen                               .
IF_EX_IERI_I_NOTIF_CUST        I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport of Data to Screen                                 .
IF_EX_IERI_I_R_CUSTR_CHECK     I CHECK_PART_CUSTR_I            Perform Customer-Specific Checks for Installation           .
IF_EX_IERI_I_R_CUSTR_CHECK     I CHECK_PART_CUSTR_R            Perform Customer-Specific Checks for Dismantling            .
IF_EX_IERI_MANDAT_IEQM0008     I MANDATORY_INSTALL             Check on mandatory fields in installation mode              .
IF_EX_IERI_MANDAT_IEQM0008     I MANDATORY_REMOVAL             Check on mandatory fields in removal mode                   .
IF_EX_IERI_R_NOTIF_CUST        I CUS_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport of Data from Screen to Customer Screen            .
IF_EX_IERI_R_NOTIF_CUST        I CUS_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport of Data from Customer Screen to Screen            .
IF_EX_IERI_R_NOTIF_CUST        I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport of Data from Screen                               .
IF_EX_IERI_R_NOTIF_CUST        I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport of Data to Screen                                 .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_INSTALL     I CUS_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport data from the screen for customer subscreen       .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_INSTALL     I CUS_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport data to the screen for customer subscreen         .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_INSTALL     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data from the screen                              .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_INSTALL     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data to the screen                                .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_REMOVAL     I CUS_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Transport data from the screen for customer subscreen       .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_REMOVAL     I CUS_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Transport data to the screen for customer subscreen         .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_REMOVAL     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport data from the screen                              .
IF_EX_IERI_USERSCR_REMOVAL     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport data to the screen                                .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I ABSORB_SUPERMINIMUM           Absorption of extra bonus to wage floor                     .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I ACTIVATE_SEL_SCREEN           Activation of extra bonus management fields on the screen   .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I CALCULATE_GROSS_SALARIES      Calculates gross planned wages                              .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I CALCULATE_SUPERMINIMUM        Calculates the new extra bonus to wage floor                .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I FINALIZATION                  Object closing operations                                   .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I INITIALIZATION                Object initialization                                       .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I IS_MODIFIED                   If the Personnel Number has been changed                    .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I PROCESSING                    Personnel Number processing for extra bonus absorption      .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I SHOW_RESULTS                  Display information about the processed personnel numbers   .
IF_EX_IF_EX_HR_IT_SUPMIN       I TO_BE_PROCESSED               If the Personnel Number should be processed                 .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_BANSTA_PUSH     I CONVERT                       Convert Banstatement(XI) to outbound format(FINSTA IDOC)    .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_BCA_ITEMS       I MODIFY_PAYMENT_ITEMS          IHC Payment Order: Transfer to BCA                          .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_CPAYORD_PLL     I CONVERT                       Convert PaymentOrder(XI) to internal  Prima Nota format     .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_CUSTOMIZING     I CHECK_DUAL_CONTROL            Replace Principle of Dual Control                           .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I CHECK_CONTAINER_FIELDS        Check Container Fields                                      .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I CONVERT_TO_EXTERNAL           Convert (Container) Field to External Format                .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I CONVERT_TO_INTERNAL           Convert (Container) Field to Internal Format                .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I DISPLAY_F4_HELP               Display F4 Help for Container Field                         .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I GET_F4_HELPS                  List of Container Fields with User-Defined F4 Help          .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I PREPARE_SELECTION             Prepare Custom Selection                                    .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_GUI_CHECKS      I RENDER_SELECTION              Edit selection                                              .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_HQ_PLUGIN       I CHANGE_ALL_PAYRQ              Change All Payment Requests                                 .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_HQ_PLUGIN       I CHANGE_SINGLE_PAYRQ           Change Payment Requests Individually                        .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_IDOC_2_PN       I CHANGE_PN_ON_IDOC             Change Payment Order Data Using an IDoc                     .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_IDOC_2_PN       I CHANGE_PN_ON_SEGMENT          Change Payment Order Data Using a Segment                   .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_IDOC_2_PN       I MODIFY_DATES                  Replace Execution, Sender/Recipient Value Date              .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_IDOC_2_PN       I MODIFY_TRNS_TYPE              Replace Transaction Type                                    .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_PAYORD_PULL     I CONVERT                       Convert PaymentOrder(XI) to internal  Prima Nota format     .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_PI_HQ           I CHANGE_ALL_PAYRQ              Change All Payment Requests                                 .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_PI_HQ           I CHANGE_SINGLE_PAYRQ           Change Payment Requests Individually                        .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_PN_2_IDOC       I MODIFY_IDOC                   Modify IDoc Data                                            .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_POST_BEHAV      I DETERMINE_POST_BEHAV          Control Posting Behavior                                    .
IF_EX_IHC_BADI_TRANS_CM        I TRANSFER                      Provision of Cash Management Data from IHC                  .
IF_EX_IHC_BANSTA_PUSH          I CONVERT                       Convert Banstatement(XI) to outbound format(FINSTA IDOC)    .
IF_EX_IHREP_EXTENSIONS         I CHANGE_ODER_OPERATION_RES     Change Results of Order- And Operation Selection            .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I ALTERNATIVE_EQUIPMENT         Valuation Changes in the Replacement Equipment Search       .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I CHANGE_EXPLOSION              Change to Structure Explosion                               .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I CHANGE_MATERIAL               Change Material Quantity from Where-Used List               .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I CHANGE_STPO                   Change BOM Components from Structure List                   .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I SEARCH_STRATEGY_FOR_EQUI      Search Strategy Change for Flexible Class Search            .
IF_EX_IHSA_LIST_EDITING        I SEARCH_STRATEGY_FOR_IFLO      Search Strategy Change for Flexible Class Search            .
IF_EX_IMRC_CHANGE_CHECK        I CHECK_CHANGES                 Compare DB Image with Changed Measurement Points/Documents  .
IF_EX_IMRC_REF_POINT_BADI      I ACTIVE_BADI_CHECK             This method is not used. See interface documentation.       .
IF_EX_IMRC_STATUS_CHECK        I CHECK_IMRG_STATUS             Check of an Additional Record of a Measuring Document       .
IF_EX_IMRM_COMP_PROCESSING     I SET_COMP_PROCESSING           Deactivation of New Component Processing                    .
IF_EX_IMRM_TL_WORKFLOWS        I REQUEST_MP_SCHEDULING         Scheduling-Relevant Changes in Task List                    .
IF_EX_IM_BEHAVIOUR             I GET_BEHAVIOUR                 Determine System Behavior                                   .
IF_EX_INPUT_CHECK_ACL          I CHECK_CNTR_UPD                Check input of counter updates                              .
IF_EX_INPUT_CHECK_ACL          I CHECK_FLIGHT                  Check flight input                                          .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_AT_SAVE                Change Inspection Lot When Saving                           .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Change Inspection Lot Before Accessing Update               .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_IN_UPDATE              Change Inspection Lot in Update                             .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_UD_AT_SAVE             Change Usage Decision When Saving                           .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_UD_BEFORE_UPDATE       Change Usage Decision Before Accessing Update               .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CHANGE_UD_IN_UPDATE           Change Usage Decision in Update                             .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CREATE_AT_SAVE                Create Inspection Lot When Saving                           .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CREATE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Create Inspection Lot Before Accessing Update               .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I CREATE_IN_UPDATE              Create Inspection Lot in Update                             .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I SET_UD_AT_SAVE                Make Usage Decision When Saving                             .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I SET_UD_BEFORE_UPDATE          Make Usage Decision Before Accessing Update                 .
IF_EX_INSPECTIONLOT_UPDATE     I SET_UD_IN_UPDATE              Make Usage Decision in Update                               .
IF_EX_INST_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I CHECK_EQUI                    Additional Authorization Checks for Equipment               .
IF_EX_INST_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I CHECK_FLOC                    Additional Authorization Checks for Functional Locations    .
IF_EX_INTERLINKAGE_CHECK       I CHECK_UPDATE_ALLOWED          Check If Change (Create/Change/Delete) Is Allowed           .
IF_EX_INTERLINKAGE_UPDATE      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Relationship Created, Deleted, or Changed                   .
IF_EX_INTERNAL_ORDER_EXTND     I ON_PAI                        PAI of Main Master Data Screen SAPMKAUF 0600                .
IF_EX_INTERNAL_ORDER_EXTND     I ON_PBO                        PBO of Main Master Data Screen SAPMKAUF 0600                .
IF_EX_INTERNAL_ORDER_EXTND     I SET_SUBSCREEN                 Register External Subscreen to be Included in Master Data   .
IF_EX_INVOICE_UPDATE           I CHANGE_AT_SAVE                Invoice Document at Save                                    .
IF_EX_INVOICE_UPDATE           I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Invoice Document Before Update                              .
IF_EX_INVOICE_UPDATE           I CHANGE_IN_UPDATE              Invoice Document During Update                              .
IF_EX_INVOIC_FI_INBOUND        I DETERMINE_TAX_CODE            Determine Tax Code for Posting Item                         .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Local Memory                                     .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I MAP_ADDITEM                   Transfer Fields in Additional Item in the Internal Display  .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I MAP_HEADER                    Transfer Fields in Document Header in the Internal Display  .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I MAP_ITEM                      Transfer Fields in Document Item in the Internal Display    .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I MAP_TAXITEM                   Transfer Fields in Tax Item in the Internal Display         .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I UPDATE                        Update                                                      .
IF_EX_INV_BAPIBILL             I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Customer Update                                     .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameters                                      .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I CHECK_REVERSAL_ORDER          Check  Reversal order                                       .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ADDITEM  Fill customer fields in additional items                    .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_HEADER   Fill ustomer fields in header                               .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ITEM     Fill customer fields in items                               .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_TAXITEM  Fill customer fields in tax items                           .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I REVERSAL_ITEM_ANALYZE         Reverse item analyse                                        .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I UPDATE                        Update database                                             .
IF_EX_INV_BILL_CANCEL          I UPDATE_PREPARE                Update prepare                                              .
IF_EX_INV_REMADV_ARCHIVE       I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Can Bill Documents Be Archived?                             .
IF_EX_INV_TRANSF_ARCHIVE       I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Can Bill Documents Be Archived?                             .
IF_EX_IPM5_CALL_INSPLOT        I INSP_LOT_STABILITY            Create Inspection Lot for Stability Study                   .
IF_EX_IPM5_CALL_INSPLOT        I STATUS_CHECK_PHYNR            Check Status of Physical Sample                             .
IF_EX_IPM_ACE_ADVANCE_BADI     I ADV_ITEM_RELEVANT             Advance Payment Item Relevant for Clearing                  .
IF_EX_IPM_ACE_ADVANCE_BADI     I MAX_RECOUP_DETERMINE          Determine Maximum Clearing Value of Advance Payment Item    .
IF_EX_IPM_ACE_ADVANCE_BADI     I ROY_ITEM_VALUE_DETERMINE      Determine Value To Be Clearing for the Royalty Item         .
IF_EX_IPM_ACE_VALTYP_BADI      I DATA_CHANGE                   Change Values That Are Adjusted in the Accrual Engine       .
IF_EX_IPM_CR_REPOST_BADI       I CHANGE_ACC_DOC                Change Transfer Posting Document                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ACT_CHECK_EXT       I PAMOD_DELETE_CHECK            Check During Mode Deletion                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_ACT_CHECK_EXT       I PAMOD_MAINT_CHECK             Check When Creating/Changing Mode                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_ACT_SORT            I PAMOD_SORT                    Mode Sort Order (PALTID)                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_ACT_TDPP            I PXXXID_TDPP_CHECK             Check iPPE Objects for TDPP                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ADD_FUNC            I CIF_ACTIVE                    Check whether Core Interface (CIF) is connected             .
IF_EX_IPPE_ADD_FUNC            I CO_ACTIVE                     Check whether Controlling (CO) is connected                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ADD_FUNC            I EXT_BROWSER_ACTIVE            Check whether PDM Browser (CC04) is connected               .
IF_EX_IPPE_ARCHIVE_CMP         I DEFINE                        Definition for Additional Tables                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ARCHIVE_CMP         I DELETE                        Delete Database Table Entries                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_ARCHIVE_CMP         I STRUCTURE_CONTENT_FILL        Fill Customer Fields When Displaying Archive                .
IF_EX_IPPE_ARCHIVE_CMP         I TREE_STRUCTURE_FILL           Add Additional Tree Nodes                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_ARCHIVE_CMP         I WRITE                         Write archive                                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAL_MMX_EXPL        I COUNT_WEIGHT_DURATION         Calculation of Weighted Duration of a Mode                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I APILOG_READ_CALO              Read Log for Configuration                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONFIG_MAINT                  Create configuration                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONFIG_READ                   Read Configuration                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONFIG_READ_MULT              Read Several Configurations                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONVERT_CMPID_E2I             Material Conversion External -" Internal                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONVERT_CMPID_I2E             Material Conversion Internal -" External                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONVERT_LOCID_E2I             Plant Conversion External -" Internal                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I CONVERT_LOCID_I2E             Plant Conversion Internal -" External                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I DEPEND_MAINT                  Create Object Dependency                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I DEPEND_READ                   Read Object Dependency                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_BAPI                I GENERATE_CONFIG               Generate Configuration                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I CREATE_COLLECTION             Returns Object Information for Product Unit for One Level   .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I CREATE_ROOT_OBJECT            Provides the Object Information for the Header of the Model .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I EXTRACTION_COMPLETE           Notifies of the End of Extraction                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I PROVIDE_IPPE_OBJECT_CATALOG   Returns Object Catalogs of iPPE Model                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I SET_EXTERNAL_CONSUMER         Defines External Application Including Extraction Options   .
IF_EX_IPPE_BY_EXTRACT          I SET_EXT_EXPL_PARAMETERS       Sets the Explosion Parameters for the External Application  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CHK                 I CMP_MODEL_CHECK               Check Model Assignment of Component for PPEHDR              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CHK                 I CONSISTENCY_CHECK             Application-Specific Consistency Checks                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CHK                 I HDR_CONSISTENCY_CHECK         Consistency Checks: Access Object and Production Version    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CHK_EXT             I CONSISTENCY_CHECK             Application-Specific Consistency Checks                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CHARACTERISTIC_CALL           Call Characteristics Maintenance                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CHARACTERISTIC_GET            Read Characteristic                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CHECK_CLASS_FOR_PXXXID        Checks for which object classification can be used          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_CHECK          Check if Classification Allowed for Node/Variant            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_COPY           Copy the Classification in the Copy of the iPPE Object      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_DELETE         Deletion of Classification                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_MAINTAIN       Maintain Classification                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_OBTAB_GET      Entry in Table OBTAB for Nodes/Variants                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_READ           Read Classification                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSIFICATION_SAVE           Save Classification                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASSTYPE_GET                 Read Class Type                                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASS_ACTIVE                  Classification system exists in system                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASS_CALL                    Call Class Maintenance                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASS_GET                     Read Classes                                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CLASS_GET_BY_RANGE            Read the Classes from RANGES Table                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CTMENU_ADD                    System-Specific Enhancement of Context Menu                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I CTMENU_SELECT                 System-Specific Execution of Context Menu Operations        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I HIERARCHY_CALL                Call Maintenance of the Class Hierarchy                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I HIERARCHY_CHECK               Check the classes for arrangement of hierarchy              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I HIERARCHY_GET                 Read hierarchy                                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I OBJECT_ALLOCATION_READ        Classification: Read Assignments to Object                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I PNODID_CHECK                  Check whether class is valid for nodes                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CLASS               I POSVID_CHECK                  Check whether class is valid for variants                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CALL                          Call up Display/Maintenance Transaction                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CALL_CMPID_FROM_SCREEN        Display/Maintenance of Component from Screen                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CHECK_BOM_DECOMPOSITION       Check whether BOM exists for component                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CHECK_BOM_FOR_DISPO           Read the BOMs for MRP Check and Recursion Check             .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CHECK_CMPID_DATA              Check component data (valid unit, quantity, ...)            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Checks existence and gets basic data (unit of measure, type).
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CHECK_VERSION_ACTIVE          Checks whether the version in the system is active          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_ACTIVE                  Check Existence of Connection to Material Master            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_CHK                     Consistency Check Function for Production Version           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_GET_BY_RANGE            Read components from RANGES table                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_LOCID_READ              Checks existence and gets plant-dependent data (CUOBJ, KMAT).
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_TEXT                    Gets the field names                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CMPID_UNLOCK                  Unlock Components                                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CONVERT_CMPID                 Conversion of components internal "-" external in iPPE      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CTMENU_ADD                    System-Specific Enhancement of Context Menu                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I CTMENU_SELECT                 System-Specific Execution of Context Menu Operations        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_CMPID_FROM_CMPEXT_RANGE   Determine Internal Material Number From CPEXT Range Table   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_CMPID_LENGTH              Read Length of Material Number                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_CMPID_PHANTOM             Checks Material for Phantom Indicator (SOBSL)               .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_DDIC_FIELD                Read DDIC Field for Material Number                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_DESCRIPTIONS              Read texts for component / component type                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_DISPO_FOR_CMPID           Read the low-level codes for the components                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_DYNPRO_INFORMATION        Gets screen and program for component display               .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_SEARCH_HELP_NAME          Read Search Help for Material Number                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_UNITS                     Read units of measure for the component                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I GET_VERSION_INFO              Gets information on the versions of components              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I HELP_INFO_CALL                Starts the Online Component Documentation                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I PLANNING_TABLE_UPDATE         Update the planning file entry                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I SET_CMPID_SPECIAL_FUNCT       Set special functions for components                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I SET_DISPO_FOR_CMPID           Set new low-level codes for components                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMPID               I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Starts the Component Input Help                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PACMP_CHECK                   Check Alternative                                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PACMP_DELETE_CHECK            Check Alternative for Deletion                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PNCMP_CHECK                   Check Node                                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PNCMP_DELETE_CHECK            Check Node for Deletion                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PVCMP_AENNR_CHANGE_CHECK      Check for Change Number Swap for Variant                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PVCMP_CHECK                   Check Variant                                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PVCMP_DELETE_CHECK            Check Variant for Deletion                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PVCOL_AENNR_CHANGE_CHECK      Check for Change Number Swap for Variant                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_EXT       I PVCOL_DELETE_CHECK            Check Variant for Deletion                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PACMP_DELETE_CHECK            System-Specific Check Before Deletion of CMP Alternative    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PACMP_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check for CMP Application Data of Alterna.  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PALTID_MAINT_CHECK            System-Specific Check for CMP Alternative ID                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PNCMP_DELETE_CHECK            System-Specific Check Before Deleting CMP Node              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PNCMP_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check for CMP Application Data of Nodes     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PNODID_MAINT_CHECK            System-Specific Check for CMP Node ID                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I POSVID_MAINT_CHECK            System-Specific Check for CMP Variant ID                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PRCMP_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check for CMP Relationship                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PVCMP_AENNR_CHANGE_CHECK      System-Specific Check Before Change Number Swap at Variant  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PVCMP_DELETE_CHECK            System-Specific Check Before Deleting CMP Variant           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PVCMP_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check of CMP Application Data of Variants   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CHECK_SYST      I PXCMP_ASSIGN_GET              Read Object Assignments (System-Specific)                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CTMENU_SYST     I CTMENU_ADD                    Context Menu Enhancements                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_CTMENU_SYST     I FCODE_EXECUTE                 Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_EXTRACT         I PVCMP_DOCID_CHANGE            Adjustment of DMU Document in the Product Structure         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_EXTRACT         I PVCMP_DOCID_COMPARE           Comparison of DMU Documents                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_REP             I ADJUST_SELECT_OPTIONS         Adjust Contents of Selection Options                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_REP             I ADJUST_WHERE_CLAUSE           Adjust WHERE Clause for Selection                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_SORT            I PACMP_SORT                    Sort Order of Alternatives (PALTID)                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_SORT            I PRPVR_SORT                    Sort Order of Assembly Relationships                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_SORT            I PVCMP_SORT                    Sort Order of Variants (POSVID)                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_CMP_SORT            I PVCOL_SORT                    Sort Order of Variants (POSVID)                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PNCOL_DELETE_CHECK            System-Specific Check Before Deleting COL Node              .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PNCOL_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check of COL Application Data of Node       .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PNODID_MAINT_CHECK            System-Specific Check of COL Node ID                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I POSVID_MAINT_CHECK            System-Specific Check of COL Variant ID                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PVCOL_AENNR_CHANGE_CHECK      System-Specific Check Before Change Number Swap at Variant  .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PVCOL_DELETE_CHECK            System-Specific Check Before Deleting COL Variant           .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PVCOL_MAINT_CHECK             System-Specific Check of COL Application Data of Variant    .
IF_EX_IPPE_COL_CHECK_SYST      I PXCOL_ASSIGN_GET              Read Object Assignments (System-Specific)                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_COPY              Copy object dependency for KNOBJ                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_DEFINITION        Maintain object dependency for KNOBJ (dialog)               .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_DELETE            Delete object dependency for KNOBJ                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_MAINTAIN          Maintain object dependency for KNOBJ (API)                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_READ              Read object dependency for KNOBJ                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I ALLOCATIONS_UPDATE_MODE       Controls the Updating of the Object Dependency              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CFG_CREATE                    Starts new configuration (Initializes SAP Configurator)     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CONFIG_ACTIVE                 Implementation exists for configuration ['X', ' ']          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_COMPLEMENT_DISJUNCTION   Fuzzy Logic - Logical NOT of a disjunction                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_DDB_CREATE_INSTANCE      Fuzzy Logic - Generate an Instance                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_DDB_SET_SELF_PARENT_ROOT Fuzzy Logic - Set formal instances $SELF $PARENT $ROOT      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_DDB_SET_VALUES_TO_INSTA  Fuzzy Logic - Set Values in the DDB                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_EVALUATE_CONDITION       Fuzzy Logic - Evaluation of Selection Condition             .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_JOIN_DISJUNCTION         Fuzzy Logic - Delete Redundant Entries                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUFE_LOG_AND_OF_DISJUNCTIONS  Fuzzy Logic - Logical AND for two disjunctions              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUKR_GET_DOCU                 Read Documentation for Relationship                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUKR_GET_SOURCES              Gets Source Text for a Given Quantity of Relationships      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUKR_INIT                     Initial Buffer for Runtime Accesses to Rel. Master Data     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_COPY                    Copy configuration                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_COPY_FOR_POSVID         Copy CUOBJ for variants                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_DELETE                  Delete CUOBJ entries                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_MAKE_CONFIGURATION      Generate CUOBJ for Side Access                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_READ                    Read Configuration                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_READ_BY_ATNAM           Determines CUOBJ Entries that use a Characteristic          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I CUOBJ_SAVE                    Save configuration                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I DBA_SELECT_PROFILES           Determines Conf. Parameters for a Configuration Object (OM) .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I EVALUATE_CONFIGURATION        Evaluate Configuration (Consistency Check)                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I FILTER_CONF_GET               Read the Configuration in Filter and Lang.-Dep. Texts       .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I FILTER_CONF_SAVE              Save Configuration Simulation for the Filter                .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I FILTER_CONF_SET_TO_INDX       Write configuration data in INDX table                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I INIT_API_CUKD                 Initializes all global variables, tables, and so on for CUKD.
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I INIT_CONFIG                   Initialization of the Configuration                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I INIT_CUXI                     Initialization and Resetting of Buffer                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I INIT_LOG_API                  Initialization of the API Environment                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I INIT_LOG_MEMORY               Initialize Log Interface                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I KNOBJ_CHK                     Consistency Check Function for Production Version           .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I KNOBJ_COPY_FOR_POSVID         Copy KNOBJ for variants                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I KNOBJ_DELETE                  Delete KNOBJ entries                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I KNOBJ_READ_BY_ATNAM           Determines KNOBJ Entries that Use a Characteristic          .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I OWNER_READ                    Determines Configuration Owner                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I PROFILE_CALL                  Access Transaction for Displaying/Editing Config. Profile   .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I PROFILE_GET                   Read Configuration Profile for Consistency Check            .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONFIG              I PROFILE_READ                  Read Configuration Profile                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_CONS                I RESTRICTIONS_SELECT           Selection of Restrictions                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_COPY_OD             I CLASS_CHANGE                  Adjust Object Dependency When Copying With Class Changes    .
IF_EX_IPPE_COPY_VS             I IPPE_COPY_VS                  Adjust Variance Scheme                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_ACTIVE                    DMU functions exist in the system                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_BUFFER_BACKUP             Note buffer content                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_BUFFER_REFRESH            Discard buffer content                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_BUFFER_RESTORE            Restore buffer content                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_COPY_FROM_PVCMP           Copy DMU data due to copy of variant                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_DELETE_FROM_PVCMP         Delete DMU data due to deletion of variant                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_DOC_CHECKOUTVIEW          Check out document for display                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_DOC_INIT                  Initialize the document search                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_DOC_SELECTION             Select Documents                                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_DOC_SELECT_PARAMS         Set selection parameters for document search                .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_INIT                      Initialization of DMU tables                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_MAINT                     Change DMU item object                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_READ_FROM_PVCMP           Read DMU item object                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_SAVE                      Save DMU tables to database                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_DMU                 I DMU_SINGLE_TMX_MAINT_PV       Change single DMU item in matrix                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CALL                          Display / Change Document                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CHECK_DOCID_IN_ENTRY          Check document assignment on entry level                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check whether document exists                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CONVERT                       Conversion: internal "-" external                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CTMENU_ADD                    System-Specific Enhancement of Context Menu                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I CTMENU_SELECT                 System-Specific Execution of Context Menu Operations        .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID2TEXT                    External key as text                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_ACTIVE                  Check Existence of Connection to Document Master            .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_GET_BY_SEARCH           Read documents for the search help                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_PARAMETER_GET           Read the document parameters (status, owner, ...)           .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_READ                    Read the attributes of a document                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_TEXT                    Identification of Connected Object (Document)               .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_UNLOCK                  Unlock Documents                                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I DOCID_VERSION_GET             Determine document version (last, ...)                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I GET_DYNPRO_INFORMATION        Screen data for displaying the object link                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I HELP_INFO_CALL                Access Online Help                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINKS_SAVE                    Save the object relationships                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_CHECK                    Check an object relationship                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_COMMUNICATION            Communication link with BAdI from DMS                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_CREATE                   Create an object relationship                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_INIT                     Initialization of the object link                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_MAINT_WITH_GUI           Maintain object relationships with GUI                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_PASS_OKCODE              Transfer of function code                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I LINK_READ                     Read object relationships                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I ORIGINAL_DISPLAY              Display the original file                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I PXXXID_COPY                   Copy Object Links (From Next Operation)                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I PXXXID_DELETE                 Next operation when deleting an iPPE object                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I SELECTION_PARAMETERS          Edit the parameters for document selection                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I URL_GET_FOR_OBJECT            Gets URL for object for thumbnail functions                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_DOCID               I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Possible entries                                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I AENNR_GET_BY_RANGE            Read the change numbers by RANGES table                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I BUFFER_TECHS_READ             Read Buffer (Effect. Variant + Overriding with Change No.)  .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CALL                          Call the transaction                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CHANGE                        Swap ECNs in an iPPE object                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CHANGE_CHECK                  Check whether possible to swap the ECN in an iPPE object    .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CHECK                         Check whether the ECN can be used in an iPPE object         .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CHECK_EFFECTIVITY             Check parameter effectivities of a change number            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check existence of ECN                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CTMENU_ADD                    System-Specific Enhancement of Context Menu                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I CTMENU_SELECT                 System-Specific Execution of Context Menu Operations        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_ACTIVE                    Check whether connection to ECM exists                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_FIELD_CHK                 ECM: Entry Check                                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_MAINTAIN                  Subsequent Operations in ECM after iPPE Operation           .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_PROCESSOR_AUTO            ECM: Selection of Valid Change Numbers                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_PROCESSOR_INIT            Initialize Data for FB ECM_PROCESSOR                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_PROC_CUST_DATA            ECM: Read the Customizing Settings                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECM_RELEASE_FLAGS             Check if Release Procedure is Active                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I ECN_DTEL_GET                  Read UI-Specific Properties of Change Number                .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I GRAPH_CHECK                   Check change statuses against change sequence graph         .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I HELP_INFO_CALL                Starts the Online Documentation for Change Number           .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I HISTORIC_OBJECTS_GET          Read Possible Object Types for Change Number                .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I PARAM_CHECK                   Check the parameters                                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I PXXXID_DELETE                 Delete the Object Management Record for iPPE Object         .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I READ                          Read Attributes of ECN                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I SEQUENCE_EVALUATE             Evaluation of the Sequenec from Change Sequence Graphic     .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I SEQUENCE_GRAPH_ACTIVE         Check Whether Change Sequence Graphic is Active             .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I TECHS_COPY                    Copy: Technical Status/Valuation                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I TECHS_CREATE_DARK             Create in the Background: Technical Status/Valuation        .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I TECHS_RENAME                  Rename: Technical Status/Valuation                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I UNLOCK                        Unlock change numbers                                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I VALIDITY_DATE_GET             Read Valid-From Date of Change Number                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Starts the Input Help for the Change Number                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN                 I VSHEME_HIST                   Check whether variance scheme can be maintained with ECN    .
IF_EX_IPPE_ECN_SORT            I EX_ECN_SORT                   Sorting of Change Statuses                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_CHECK_EXT       I PALTID_EXT_NAME_CHECK         Customer-Specific Check for External Name of an Alternative .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_CHECK_EXT       I PNODID_EXT_NAME_CHECK         Customer-Specific Check for External Name of a Node         .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_CHECK_EXT       I POSVID_EXT_NAME_CHECK         Customer-Specific Check for External Name of a Variant      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_CHECK_EXT       I PRELID_EXT_NAME_CHECK         Customer-Specific Check for External Name of a Relationship .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_CUST            I CHECK_CCODE_FIELDS            Check Values for Color Code and Offset                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_EX     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get Data from Interface                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_EX     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data to Interface                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_EX     I SET_TABS                      Selection of Active Tab Titles at iPPE Load Dialog Box      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_SY     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get Data from Interface                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_SY     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data to Interface                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_GUI_LOAD_SY     I SET_TABS                      Selection of Active Tab Titles at iPPE Load Dialog Box      .
IF_EX_IPPE_ENG_SORT            I PRELID_SORT                   Sort Order for PRELID Records                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPLCU_EVALUATE               Evaluation of Object Dependency                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPLCU_GET_CONFIGURATION      Determine the Characteristic Valuation (Also w. dialog box) .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_CMPID_CHK                Read Material Data Controlling the Explosion                .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_CMP_DATA_GET             Read the material data for the explosion                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_EXPLOSION_CO             Explosion for Controlling                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_EXPLOSION_MRP            Explosion for Material Requirements Planning                .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_HANDLE_APG               Consideration of the Alternative Item Group                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_MV_CMPID_SINGLE_ENTRY_GETCheck Validity of PVS with Material from Production Version .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_MV_LOOSE_REF_IPPE        Explosion                                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL                I EXPL_TDP_MERGE                Merge Function for  TDP                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLACT             I CO_SORT_ACTIVITIES            Sort activities for displaying the costing data             .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLACT             I RTO_COMPLETE_RTOBJ            SA and RP Assignments for Explosion of Shop Floor           .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLACT             I RTO_EXPL_SEQGROUPS            Format the sequence for the runtime object                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLACT             I RTO_GET_RPP_STRUCT            Generates Reporting Point Runtime Object for Activities     .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLFLO             I EXPLODE_RTOBJ                 Explosion Runtime Object for Production Lines               .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPLFLO             I GET_LRES_TAKT_TIME            Determine Takt Time From Line Resource                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL_EVAL_EXT       I LASTNCHSTAT_EVALUATE          Evaluation of Last 'n' Change Statuses                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL_EVAL_EXT       I TIMEWINDOWS_EVALUATE          Evaluation of Change Statuses Within Date Interval          .
IF_EX_IPPE_EXPL_EXT            I HANDLE_ACTIVITY               Handle Activity Assigned to 'External' BOM                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_FILTER_ATTR         I OBJ_ATTR_CORRELATION          Object/Attribute Correlation                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_FILTER_EXT          I FILTER_NODE                   Filters Node According To Filter Settings                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_FILTER_EXT          I OBJ_ATTR_CORRELATION          Change Object/Attribute Correlation                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_FLO                 I INVALIDATE_FLO_MATRIX         Invalidate FLO Matrix                                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_FLO                 I INVALIDATE_REPPOINT_VERSION   Invalidate RP version when master data is changed           .
IF_EX_IPPE_FLO                 I MODELMIX_ACTIVE               Active Model Mix                                            .
IF_EX_IPPE_FLO                 I PATH_TIMESTAMP_SET            Set Time Stamp From FLO Path to Top                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_GIFOC_EXTRACT       I GET_CTMENUE_FOR_EXTR          Gets menu entry for extraction                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_GIFOC_EXTRACT       I TRIGGER_ACTION_FOR_EXTR       Starts action for extraction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I CMPID_GET_PROPERTY            Check Type for Material                                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I CMPID_HEAD_USE                Replace Material Version with Header Material               .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I CMPID_VERS_CHECK              Check Access Data Found for Material Version                .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I CMPID_VERS_USE                Replace Header Material with Material Version               .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I COSTPROFILE_CONVERT           Convert SNP Cost Profile                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I GET_PRODVER                   Read Production Versions                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_BUFFER_BACKUP             Save Buffer                                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_BUFFER_REFRESH            Delete Buffer                                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_BUFFER_RESTORE            Restore Saved Buffer in Original Buffer                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_READ                      Read Change Pointer From Buffer                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_RTO_GEN                   Generate PDS                                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_SAVE                      Save Change Pointer                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_SYST_DEL_CHECK            System-Specific Check when Deleting Access Object           .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I HDR_SYST_MAINT_CHECK          System-Specific Check when Maintaining Access Object        .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I INVALIDATE_REPPOINT_VERSION   Invalidate Reporting Point                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I PRODVER_CIF_CREATE_PRODVER    Create production version using CIF                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I PRODVER_GET_SUBSCREEN_DATA    Get the data from the initial screen                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I PRODVER_NOTIFY_PLANING        Notification from planning                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I PRODVER_PUT_SUBSCREEN_DATA    Transfer the data to the initial screen                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_HDR                 I RTO_INVALIDATE                Create Change Pointer                                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_HIPDV_EXT           I PATYPE_DETERMINE              Determine Alternative Type                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_HIPDV_EXT           I PNTYPE_DETERMINE              Determine Node Type                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_HIPDV_EXT           I PRTYPE_DETERMINE              Determine Dependency Type                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_HIPDV_EXT           I PVTYPE_DETERMINE              Determine Variant Type                                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Checks Existence of Location                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I CONVERT_LOCID                 Conversion of location internal "-" external                .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I GET_DDIC_FIELD                Reading DDIC Field for Location                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I GET_IMPL_TYPE                 Gets properties of system-specific location                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I GET_LOCID_FROM_LOCEXT_RANGE   Gets Internal ID for External ID Selection Table            .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I GET_PARAMETER_ID              Gets content from parameter ID for location                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I HELP_INFO_CALL                Starts the Online Documentation for Location                .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I LOCID_ACTIVE                  Plant/location is available in the system                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I LOCID_LENGTH                  Gets the field length of the location                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I LOCID_TEXT                    Gets the field name                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I MRP_AREA_READ                 Gets MRP Areas for Location/Sublocation                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I SET_PARAMETER_ID              Sets content of parameter ID for location                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_LOCID               I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Starts the Input Help for Location                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I ACTHD_FILL                    Fill Customer Enhancement for Routing Header                .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I ACTST_FILL                    Fill Customer Enhancement for Routing                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I CMPHD_FILL                    Fill Customer Enhancement for Header of Product Structure   .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I CMPST_FILL                    Fill Customer Enhancement for Product Structure             .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I HDR_FILL                      Fill Customer Enhancement for Production Version            .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_EXT             I NROBJ_GET                     Fill Data for Number Range Object for Naming                .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_SYST            I FCAT_ADJUST                   System-Specific Adjustments of Feld Catalog                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_SYST            I STATUS_SET                    Set System-Specific GUI Status                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_SYST            I TITLE_GET                     Read System-Specific Table Titles                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_LUI_SYST            I USER_COMMAND                  Process System-Specific Commands of User                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I GET_IMPL_TYPE                 Gets type of implementation (APO-Res, proxy object, none)   .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I LINERES_UPDATE_TAKTS          Change the number of takts for the line resource            .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I PLANRES_ACTIVE                Active planning resource exists in the system               .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I PLANRES_CALL                  Call the display/change transaction                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I PLANRES_DTEL_GET              Read UI-Specific Properties of Planning Resource            .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I PLANRES_MAINT                 Maintain a Planning Resource                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I PLANRES_READ                  Read a Planning Resource                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_PLANRES             I READ_COST_RESOURCE            Reads CO Resoure Data                                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I CTMENU_ADD                    System-Specific Enhancement of Context Menu                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I CTMENU_SELECT                 System-Specific Execution of Context Menu Operations        .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I GET_DDIC_FIELD                Read the DDIC Field for Production Version                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I HELP_INFO_CALL                F1 Help for Name of Production Version                      .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_ACTIVE                Check whether connection to a production version exists     .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_BUFFER_BACKUP         Save Buffer                                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_BUFFER_REFRESH        Delete Buffer                                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_BUFFER_RESTORE        Restore Saved Buffer in Original Buffer                     .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_DELETE                Delete a Production Version                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_GET_BY_RANGES         Read the Production Versions By RANGES Tables               .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_KEY_CONVERT           Reads Internal Production Version Key for PPEGUID           .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_MAINT                 Maintain a Production Version                               .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_MODEL_ADD             Assignment of Model for Production Version                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_MODEL_DEL             Delete Model Assignment for Production Version              .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_MODEL_READ            Reads Assigned Model for Production Version                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_ORDER_EXISTS          Check whether orders exist for a production version         .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_READ                  Read a Production Version                                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_READ_MULT             Read Multiple Production Versions                           .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_RTO_ACTIVE            Checks if PDS Connection Exists                             .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_RTO_DISPLAY           PDS Display                                                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_RTO_GEN               Generate Runtime Objects                                    .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_RTO_STATUS_GET        Reads Status of PDS and Corresponding Icon                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_SAVE                  Save the production versions                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_TEXT                  Read the texts for the production version                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I PRODVER_USABLE_FOR_PPE        Check whether production version can be used for iPPE       .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Search Help for Name of Production Version                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_PRODVER             I VERID_LENGTH                  Length of Name of Production Version                        .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I EKG                           Data Analysis and Correction                                .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I PS_ACTIVE                     Check whether connection to Project System exists           .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I PS_CONVERT                    Conversion of Project Identification: Internal "-" External .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I PS_GET_BY_OBJECT              Read the PS objects/data assigned to the iPPE object        .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I PS_GET_BY_RANGES              Read the assigned PS objects from the RANGES table          .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS                  I PS_TRANSFER                   Transfer to Project System                                  .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS_EXT              I IPPE_PS_TRANSFER              Transfer iPPE Information to Project System                 .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS_LINK             I DELETE_IPPE_PS_LINK           Delete IPPE PS link                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS_LINK             I GET_SCREEN_INSTANCE           Get subscreen program name and screen number                .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS_LINK             I PUT_DATA                      Set Data for Screen                                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_PS_LINK             I SAVE_DATA                     Save data of IPPE link with PS                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_SETUPGROUP          I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check whether a setup group exists in a plant/location      .
IF_EX_IPPE_SETUPGROUP          I SETUPGROUP_ACTIVE             Active setup group exists in system                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_STRUCT_MATCH        I OBJ_MATCH_1                   Matching Algorithm 1 for Comparison                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_STRUCT_MATCH        I OBJ_MATCH_2                   Matching Algorithm 2 for Comparison                         .
IF_EX_IPPE_SUPPLYAREA          I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check whether the SA exists in a plant/location             .
IF_EX_IPPE_SUPPLYAREA          I HELP_INFO_CALL                Starts the Online Documentation for Supply Area             .
IF_EX_IPPE_SUPPLYAREA          I SUPPLYAREA_ACTIVE             Active SA exists in the system                              .
IF_EX_IPPE_SUPPLYAREA          I SUPPLYAREA_READ               Read a Supply Area                                          .
IF_EX_IPPE_SUPPLYAREA          I VALUE_INFO_CALL               Starts the Input Help for Supply Area                       .
IF_EX_IPPE_TEXT                I GET_TEXT                      Gets the appropriate texts for the fields                   .
IF_EX_IPPE_UITS                I TS_SET_SCR_EXCL_TAB           Transfer Screen Exclusion Table                             .
IF_EX_IPRM_CHECK_UPD_SCHED     I CHECK_MHIO                    Check the Maintenance Call Objects                          .
IF_EX_IPRM_CHECK_UPD_SCHED     I CHECK_MHIS                    Check the Schedule Dates                                    .
IF_EX_IPRM_DIG_SIGNATURE       I DIG_SIGNATURE_MAINT_ITEM      Digital Signature for Maintenance Item                      .
IF_EX_IPRM_DIG_SIGNATURE       I DIG_SIGNATURE_MAINT_PLAN      Digital Signature for Maintenance Plan (Master Data)        .
IF_EX_IPRM_DIG_SIGNATURE       I DIG_SIGNATURE_MAINT_PLAN_SCHEDDigital Signature for Maintenance Plan (Scheduling)         .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_DATE_I_PAST     I PLANNED_DATE_PAST             Plan Date in the Past                                       .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_SCHE_CHANGE     I CALC_COUNTER_READ_CYCLE       Calculate Next Counter Reading for Performance-Based Cycle  .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_SCHE_CHANGE     I CALC_PLANNED_DATE_CYCLE       Calculate Next Plan Date for Time-Based Cycle               .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_SCHE_CHANGE     I CALC_PLANNED_DATE_CYCLE_CR    Calculate Next Plan Date for Performance-Based Cycle        .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_SCHE_CHANGE     I SET_REF_COUNTER_READ_CYCLE    Set Start Counter Reading for Performance-Based Cycle       .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_SCHE_CHANGE     I SET_REF_TIMESTAMP_CYCLE       Set Start Time for Time-Based Cycle                         .
IF_EX_IPRM_MCP_UPD_CALLOBJ     I UPD_CALLED_CALL               Adjust Plan/Basic Dates of Generated Call Objects           .
IF_EX_IQS0_STATUS_MAINTAIN     I SET_DISPLAY_FLAG              Control of DISPLAY_ONLY Parameter for Status Maintenance    .
IF_EX_IQS_MASS_CHANGE          I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authority Check                                             .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_ESCR_FRC_JIT      I CHANGE_SELECTED_DATA          Change Read Values Before Preparation in Smart Form         .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_HSC_VAT           I GET_VAT_RELEVANCE             Controls the Sales Tax Relevance of the Handling Surcharge  .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_MRER              I CHANGE_DATA                   Change the Data per Settlement Item                         .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_MRER              I CHANGE_HSC_VALUE              Calculate the Surcharge Value                               .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_MRER              I CHANGE_PREPARED_DATA          Change the Header/Item Fields of the Invoice Document       .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_MRER              I CHANGE_SPLIT_LIMIT            Split Limit for Document Selection                          .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_MRER              I READ_REFERENCE_DATA           Data Formatting and Check                                   .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_REVALUATION       I CHANGE_MESSAGE_TYPE           Preparation for Results Log                                 .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_REVALUATION       I SELECT_DATA                   Selection of work list                                      .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_REVALUATION_1     I CHECK_AMOUNT                  Method  für Value Check                                     .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_SUE_BACKLOG       I CHANGE_DATA_DETLIST           Change Data for Detail List                                 .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_SUE_BACKLOG       I CHANGE_DATA_OVLIST            Change Data for Overview List                               .
IF_EX_ISAUTO_TOLERANCE         I TOLERANCE_CHECK               Tolerance Check                                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_APPVIEW_FIELD     I FILL_FIELDS                   Appointment List: Fill Customer-Specific Fields             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I ASSIGN                        Link an Object with Base Item                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I CHECK                         Check Object-Specific Part of Definition                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I DO                            Execute Action                                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I GET_INFO                      Base Item Information as MIME Object (e.g. HTML)            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I PRINT                         Print Base Item Information                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I RESULT_TO_GENERICTAB          Convert Result into Generic Table                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I SERIALIZE_RESULT              Convert Result                                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_ACT      I TRANSPORT                     Create Object List for CTS                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_DEF      I GET_INSTANCE_BASEITEM         Read Instance of Base Item API in Maintenance Screen        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_RES      I DELETE                        Delete Result                                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_RES      I LOAD                          Load Result                                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_RES      I SAVE                          Save Result                                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_USE      I GET_WHERE_IS_USED             Determine Use of Base Item                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_USE      I GET_WHERE_IS_USED_RUNTIME     Determine Use of Base Item for Runtime                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BASEITEM_USE      I GET_WHERE_IS_USED_RUNTIME_DEEPDetermine Use of Base Item for Runtime (Deep)               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_COMPONENT     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_COMPONENT     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_COMPONENT     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_COMPONENT     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_CORDER        I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_CORDER        I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_CORDER        I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_CORDER        I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_DIAGNOSIS     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_DIAGNOSIS     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_DIAGNOSIS     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_DIAGNOSIS     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PATHWAY       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PATHWAY       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PATHWAY       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PATHWAY       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROBLEM       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROBLEM       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROBLEM       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROBLEM       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROCEDURE     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROCEDURE     I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROCEDURE     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROCEDURE     I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROGRESS      I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROGRESS      I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROGRESS      I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_PROGRESS      I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_SERVADM       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_SERVADM       I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_SERVADM       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_SERVADM       I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_TA            I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_TA            I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_TA            I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_TA            I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_URL           I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_URL           I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_URL           I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_BIX_URL           I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_CASE_ASSIGN       I DEFINE_CASE                   Define a Case for Case Assignment                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_CDOKU_CALL        I CHIRDOKU_CALL                 Data Transfer for Calling the Surgical Documentation        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_CDOKU_RELEASE     I CHIRDOKU_RELEASE              Actions After Surgical Documentation Release                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_CDOKU_SAVE        I CHIRDOKU_SAVE                 Actions After Saving Surgical Documentation                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT       I GET                           Get Document Content                                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TITLEBAR      I SET_TITLEBAR                  Setting Title of a Window                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I CHANGE_RECEIVED_STRUCTURED    Modify Document Data on Receipt                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I CHANGE_RECEIVED_XML           Modify XML Message on Receipt                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I CHANGE_SEND_STRUCTURED        Modify Document Data Before Dispatch                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I CHANGE_SEND_XML               Modify XML Message Before Dispatch                          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I ON_DOCUMENT_ASSIGNED          Event: Doc Was Assigend to a Patient and Created            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I ON_DOCUMENT_RECEIVED          Event: Document Acceptance Completed (Poss. with Errors)    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I ON_DOCUMENT_SENT              Event: Document Transfer Completed                          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DOC_TRANSFER      I ON_RESPONSE_RECEIVED          Event: Partner Confirmation Dispatched Doc Received         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DPLAUTH_CHECK     I CHECK                         Check Day-Related Plan. Authority and Time Slot Modification.
IF_EX_ISHMED_DWS_CTX_VIEW      I DISPLAY                       Display Output Area                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DWS_OPTIONS       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport from Subscreen                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_DWS_OPTIONS       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport to Subscreen                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_FALL_LIST         I FILL_FIELD                    Fill "Medical Text" Field in Case List                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_FO_PRINT          I SET_PRINT_PARAMETER           Set Printer Parameters for XSL:FO Printout                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_FO_TRANSFORM      I DO_TRANSFORMATION             Execute Transformation                                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_FO_XML_DATA       I ENHANCE_XML_DATA              Enhance XML for XSL:FO Printout with Additional Data        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_BADI       I ACTION                        Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_DOC        I AFTER_ACTION                  After Editing Document                                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_DOC        I AFTER_REDO                    After Repeated Execution                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_DOC        I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before Editing Documents                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_DOC        I BEFORE_REDO                   Before Repeated Execution                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_REQ        I AFTER_ACTION                  After Creating Request (First Time)                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_REQ        I AFTER_ACTION_REDO             After Creating Request (Repeated)                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_REQ        I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before Creating Request (First Time)                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_REQ        I BEFORE_ACTION_REDO            Before Creating Request (Repeated)                          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SC         I AFTER_ACTION                  After SAPscript Print (First Time)                          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SC         I AFTER_ACTION_REDO             After SAPscript Print (Repeated)                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SC         I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before SAPscript Print (First Time)                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SC         I BEFORE_ACTION_REDO            Before SAPscript Print (Repeated)                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SF         I AFTER_ACTION                  After Smart Forms Print (First Time)                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SF         I AFTER_ACTION_REDO             After Smart Forms Print (Repeated)                          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SF         I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before Smart Forms Print (First Time)                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_SF         I BEFORE_ACTION_REDO            Before Smart Forms Print (Repeated)                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_WO         I AFTER_ACTION                  After Work Organizer Print (First Time)                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_WO         I AFTER_ACTION_REDO             After Work Organizer Print (Repeated)                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_WO         I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before Work Organizer Print (First Time)                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_ACT_WO         I BEFORE_ACTION_REDO            Before Work Organizer Print (Repeated)                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_CASE           I SELECT_CURRENT                Select Current Case                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_GL_PATINFO        I GET_TEXT                      Return User Text                                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_LTE_FILL_TAG      I FILL_TAG                      Fill Tag from DB                                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_MBS_UPD_TAB       I SET_STATUS_DOC                Set the Document Status                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_MBS_UPD_TAB       I SET_STATUS_FLD                Set the Status of the Field in the Document                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_ACT_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check Following Activation Mode Change                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_ACT_SAVE       I PREALLOCATE                   Preset Attributes at Creation                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_ACT_SAVE       I SAVE                          Save Changed Activation Mode                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_CALL_PRPRI     I AFTER_PRINT                   Method After Print Was Executed                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_CALL_PRPRI     I BEFORE_ADMINISTER             Method Before Events Were Administered                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_CALL_PRPRI     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Method for Presetting/Deactivating Dialog                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_CALL_PRPRI     I BEFORE_PRINT                  Method Before Print Prescription Was Executed               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_DRUG_SUBST     I SEARCH_ALTERNATIVE            Find Alternatives                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_DRUG_SUBST     I SEARCH_OTHER_PKGSIZE          Find Same Drug, Different Container Size                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXPRESNR       I GET_EXPRESNR                  Fill External Number                                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_CHANGE_ORD I CHANGE_ORDER                  Display or Change Orders                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_COPY_ORDER I COPY_ORDER                    Copy Orders                                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_END_ORDER  I END_ORDER                     End Orders                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_EXTD_ORDER I EXTEND_ORDER                  Extend Orders                                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_ORDER_AUTH I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization for Specific Function                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_EXT_SUSP_ORDER I SUSPEND_ORDER                 Suspend Orders                                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FORM_CHECK     I CHECK                         Check Drug                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FORM_FLAGS     I GET_FORMULARY_FLAGS           Determine Control Flag for Dialog and Data Transfer         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MAINDET     I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Modification of Screen                                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MENU        I CUSTOMER_FNC_1                Customer Function 1 for Drug Administration                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MENU        I CUSTOMER_FNC_2                Customer Function 2 for Drug Administration                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MENU        I CUSTOMER_FNC_3                Customer Function 3 for Drug Administration                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MONOURL     I FINALIZE                      Finalize Object                                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_MONOURL     I GET_URL                       Create URL                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_SEARCH      I IS_SEARCH_REPLACED            Check Whether Entire Search Is to Be Replaced               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_SEARCH      I SEARCH                        Find                                                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER01      I PROZESS_PAI                   Start at PAI Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER01      I PROZESS_PBO                   Start at PBO Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER01      I SAVE                          Save User-Specific Data                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER02      I PROZESS_PAI                   Start at PAI Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER02      I PROZESS_PBO                   Start at PBO Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER02      I SAVE                          Save User-Specific Data                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER03      I PROZESS_PAI                   Start at PAI Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER03      I PROZESS_PBO                   Start at PBO Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USER03      I SAVE                          Save Own Data                                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USERL1      I PROZESS_PAI                   Start at PAI Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_FO_USERL1      I PROZESS_PBO                   Start at PBO Time                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IMP_AGENT      I LOAD_UPDATE_DATA              Read UPDATE Data                                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IMP_BDCC       I LOAD_DATA_1                   Read External Drugs and Their Agents 1                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IMP_BDCC       I LOAD_DATA_2                   Read External Drugs and Their Agents 2                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IMP_BDCC       I LOAD_DATA_3                   Read External Drugs and Their Agents 3                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_AVCHECK     I CHECK_AVAILABLE_IN_MM         Check Whether Drug Is Available in Storage                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_AVCHECK     I CHECK_BY_MATNR                Check Availability with Material Number etc                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CH_PREP     I MODIFY_ALV_BAGS               Modify Grid Information of Bag                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CH_PREP     I MODIFY_ALV_PREPARATIONS       Modify Grid Information of Preparation                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CH_RES      I CHANGE_DEL_RESERVATION        Change or Delete Reservations in MM                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CO_CANC     I CANCEL_CO_POSTING             Cancel CO Posting                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CO_CANC     I CANCEL_GOODS_ISSUE_POSTING    Cancel Goods Issue Posting                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CO_POST     I TRANSFER_CO_POSTING           Transfer Costs from Cost Center to Case                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CR_GMVT     I CREATE_GOODSMOVEMENT          Create Goods Movement                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CR_MM       I CREATE_ASSIGN                 Assign or Create Material Master for Drug                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_CR_RES      I CREATE_RESERVATION            Create Reservations in MM                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_DT_FSOU     I DETERMINATE_FILLSOURCE        Determine Collection Location                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_EX_CALC     I CALCULATE                     Calculate Drug Quantity External                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_1                Customer Function 1 for Infusions                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_2                Customer Function 2 for Infusions                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_3                Customer Function 3 for Infusions                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_4                Customer Function 1 for Compounds                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_5                Customer Function 2 for Compounds                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_FNC_PRP     I CUSTOMER_FNC_6                Customer Function 3 for Compounds                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_IM_LABEL       I PRINT_LABEL                   Output Label for Drug                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_ORDERDESCR     I CHANGE_ORDERDESCR             Change of Description of Order                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_ORDER_PURP     I DEFAULT_PURPOSE               Preset Purpose of Order                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PICK_FILLL     I CHANGE_HEADER                 Change Header of Pick List/Fill List                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PICK_FILLL     I CHANGE_ITEM                   Change Items of Pick List/Fill List                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PICK_FILLL     I CHANGE_TITLE                  Define Header for Pick List/Fill List                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_CHECK       I AFTER_LIST                    After Selection Screen Display                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_CHECK       I BEFORE_LIST                   Before Selection Screen Display                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_DATA        I MODIFY_DATA                   Change Data Table                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_PRINT       I PRINT                         Print List                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_PRINT_L     I PRINT                         Print Labels                                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_SELECT      I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values of Selection Screen                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_SELECT      I IS_SELECT_REPLACED            Replace Entire Data Selection?                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_SELECT      I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Modify Selection Screen                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_SELECT      I MODIFY_VALUES                 Changes Data of Selection Screen                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PL_SELECT      I SELECT                        Modify/Execute Data Selection                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PRSC_DOC       I GET_DOC_CATEGORY              Define Country-Specific Doc Type and Doc Type Vers          .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PRSC_DOC       I GET_GROUPING                  MEEVTID Distribution to Documents                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PRSC_DOC       I SYNCHRONIZE                   Adjustment Between Event and Document                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_PRSC_PRN       I PRINT                         Print                                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCHCPOE     I MODIFY_FIELDS                 Modify Display Fields in Search                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCHCPOE     I SEARCH                         External Drug Search                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_BDC     I IS_SEARCH_REPLACED            Check Whether Entire Search Is to Be Replaced               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_BDC     I PROZESS_PAI                   -- Do not Use Anymore --                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_BDC     I PROZESS_PBO                   -- Do not Use Anymore --                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_BDC     I SEARCH                        Find in BDC                                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_EXT     I CALL_BROWSER                  Calls a Browser                                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_PBO     I PROZESS_PAI                   Enhance Selection Screen with Own Fields                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARCH_PBO     I PROZESS_PBO                   Enhance Selection Screen with Own Fields                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARC_TMPL     I CREATE_SEARCH_FIELD           Create Additional Search Field                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARC_TMPL     I HANDLE_F1_HELP_BTN            Handling Routine for F1 Help Button                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARC_TMPL     I HANDLE_F4_HELP_BTN            Handling Routine for Input Help (F4) Button                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARC_TMPL     I HANDLE_SEL_OPT_BTN            Handling Routine for Further Selection Options Button       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_SEARC_TMPL     I SEARCH                        Search                                                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_WP_015         I DESTROY                       Deconstructing View                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_WP_015         I FUNCTION                      Call Customer-Specific Functions                            .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_WP_015         I SELECTION_BEGIN               Call BEFORE Standard Selection                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_ME_WP_015         I SELECTION_END                 Call AFTER Standard Selection                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PATSEARCH         I CRITERIA_SET                  Set Search Criteria                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PCTOOLS_BEGIN     I START                         Before PC DOcument is Called                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PCTOOLS_END       I START                         After PC Document is Called                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PMD_TO_XML        I WORK_ON_DATA                  Data Postprocessing                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PREFETCHING       I PREFETCH_LEISTUNGEN           Prefetching Algorithm                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PROC_DIA_ENCD     I ENCODE_DIAG_PROCEDURES        External Combined Diagnosis / Procedure Coding              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PROC_ENCODING     I ENCODE_PROCEDURES             External Procedure Coding                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_PROC_ENC_HITL     I ENCODE_PROCEDURES_HITL        External Procedure Coding via Hit List                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP       I MAP                           Assigns IS-H*MED RAD Attributes to Def. Structure           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CANCEL_SERVICE                Cancel Service                                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CHANGESTATE_CORDPOS           Convert Item Status in Clinical Order                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CHANGE_CASE                   Create Case Reference for Services with Appointment         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CHECK_TREATMENT               Treat Patient (Check)                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CHECK_UNDO_RESOLVE_SERVICES   Reverse Replacement                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I CREATE_SERVICES               Create Services with Case and Appt Reference                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I QUIT_SERVICE                  Perform/Release Service                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I RESOLVE_SERVICE               Replace Service                                             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I SAVE_APPOINTMENT              Appt Allocation for Case-Related Services                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_BASE          I SAVE_TREATMENT                Treat Patient (Save)                                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_CONVERT       I CONVERT                       Convet a Value into Target Format                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_EXAMVIEW      I GET_EXAM_STATUS_TABLE         Get Standard Table of Status for Exam Document              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_GEN_UID       I GENERATE_STUDY_IUID           Generates study instance UID                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_LSTUDY        I LOAD_STUDY                    Load Study                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_LS_EXE        I START                         Start the Program                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_LS_URL        I START                         Start the Browser                                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_MPPS_PROC     I PROCESS                       Processing of MPPS Object                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_PA_EXSTAT     I PROCESS                       Process something on Filter RadExam Status                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_RESULTDTA     I GET_EVTTYPE_DATA              Return Attrib-Value-List of Filtered Event Type             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_SPWL          I SEND_WORKLIST                 RAD: Transmit Worklist Entries with Your Tools              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_STUDYID       I GENERATE_STUDY_ID             Generate Study Ident                                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_STUDY_EVT     I GET_EVTTYPE_DATA              Return Attrib-Value-List of Filtered Event Type             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_RAD_WLDETAILS     I SHOW_ITEM_DETAILS             Display Radiological Examination Details                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_SEL_FOR_FALLB     I EXECUTE                       Restrict Data Displayed in Selection Popup                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_TGPL_COLHEAD      I ASSIGN_COLHEADER              Create Column Headers                                       .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_ITEMSAVE       I READ                          Reads Item                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_ITEMSAVE       I SAVE                          Saves Item                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I CHECK                         Checks Consistency of Progress Entry Objects                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I CLOSE                         Process when Closing Entry                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I GET_DATA                      Read Data from Progress Entry Object                        .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I OPEN                          Process when Opening Entry                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I SET_DATA                      Set Data in Progress Entry Object                           .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_NOTE_INPUT     I SET_DISPLAY_MODE              Set Display or Edit Mode                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I ADD_NOTE                      Add Progress Entry to PD View                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I CLEAR                         Delete PD View                                              .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I FINALIZE                      Finalize                                                    .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I PRINT                         Print PD View                                               .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I REFRESH                       Refresh and Display PD View                                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VD_VIEW           I SEARCH                        Find Progress Entry or Text in PD View                      .
IF_EX_ISHMED_VISITSEQ_CHEC     I CHECK                         Check Visits and Services in Visit Sequence                 .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_01_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS01                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_01_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD01                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_02_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS02                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_02_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD02                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_03_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS03                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_03_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD03                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_04_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS04                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_04_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD04                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_05_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS05                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_05_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD05                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_06_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS06                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_06_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD06                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_07_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS07                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_07_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD07                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_08_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS08                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_08_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD08                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_09_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS09                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_09_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD09                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_10_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS10                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_10_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD10                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_11_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS11                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_11_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD11                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_12_DIS       Execute Function Code +DIS12                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORDCONTAINER     I DO_FUNCTION_CODE_12_MOD       Execute Function Code +MOD12                                .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORD_DOCTYP       I SET_BUTTONS                   Activate Pushbutton Bar                                     .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORD_SAVE         I SAVE                          After Saving WordContainer Document                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORD_UPD          I UPDATE_DOCUMENT               Call Occurs Before Document Appears                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WORKLIST          I GET_SERVICES                  IS-H*MED RAD: Get the Services for the Worklist             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WP_DOC            I CHANGE_SELECT_CRITERIA        Change Selection Criteria                                   .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WP_DOC            I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Change Data Display                                         .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WP_DOC            I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Override Functions, Customer-Specific Functions             .
IF_EX_ISHMED_WP_DOC            I SELECTION                     Make Selection                                              .
IF_EX_ISH_API_PREREQUISITS     I CHECK_PREREQUISITS            Check Prerequisites Prior to API/BAPI Call                  .
IF_EX_ISH_APPT_EXT             I GET_MAX_PERIOD_APPTS          Determine Default and Maximum Values Appt List Ext. Phy.    .
IF_EX_ISH_BP_CHECK             I BP_DATA_CHECK                 Check General Business Partner Data                         .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_CUSTOMER      I CHANGE                        Modify the PCS Data                                         .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_EXTRACT       I GET_BILL_KEY_FIGURES          Determine Billing Key Figures                               .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_EXTRACT       I GET_MD_KEY_FIGURES            Determine Medical Documentation Key Figures                 .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_EXTRACT       I GET_OTHER_KEY_FIGURES         Determine Other Key Figures                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_EXTRACT       I PREPARE_ENRICH                Data Selection for Derivation                               .
IF_EX_ISH_BW_PCS_EXTRACT       I SET_REF_DATE                  Determine Reference Date                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_CASCAT_SELECTION     I CHANGE_SELECTION              Modification of Case Category Selection                     .
IF_EX_ISH_CASELIST_CASEFLD     I GET_CASE_FIELD                Add Case Level User Field to Case List                      .
IF_EX_ISH_CASELIST_CASEFLD     I GET_CASE_FIELD_TITLE          Add Case Level User Field Title to Case List                .
IF_EX_ISH_CASELIST_MVMTFLD     I GET_MVMT_FIELD                Add Movement Level User Field to Case List                  .
IF_EX_ISH_CASELIST_MVMTFLD     I GET_MVMT_FIELD_TITLE          Add Movement Level User Field Title to Case List            .
IF_EX_ISH_CONTRACT_MAXIMUM     I MAXIMUM_COMPUTE               Calculate Maximum Amount                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_COPAY_REPAY          I REPAY_POSTED                  Information that Repayment Was Posted                       .
IF_EX_ISH_COPAY_TRANSFER       I CHANGE                        Change Document Structure                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_DE_DRG_SC_FOREIG     I SET_FOREIGNER_FLAG            Disable DRG System Surcharge for Foreign Cases              .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CUST       I CHANGE                        Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CUST       I CHECK                         Check Diagnosis                                             .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CUST       I CREATE                        Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CVERS      I CHANGE                        Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CVERS      I CHECK                         Check Diagnosis                                             .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CVERS      I CHECK_DOCVIEW                 Check Diagnoses of a Department                             .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CVERS      I CHECK_GLOBAL                  Check All Diagnoses for a Case                              .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CVERS      I CREATE                        Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_DCOD       I RNDIA_DCOD                    Transfer of Diagnostic Coding                               .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I COPY                          Copy a Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I OVERVIEW                      Change Diagnosis Overview                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I RNDIA_BLANK                   Default Values for New Diagnosis                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I RNDIA_CHANGE                  Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I RNDIA_CREATE                  Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_NP61       I SECTION_TEXT                  Change Short Text for Department Stay                       .
IF_EX_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_SORT       I DEFAULT                       Change Default Sort Sequence                                .
IF_EX_ISH_DOP_DEDUCTION        I CHECK_DEDUCTION                Decide Whether Down Payment to Be Deducted                 .
IF_EX_ISH_DRGCASE_CHECK        I DRG_BILLING_RELEVANT          Is the Case Relevant for DRG Billing According to KHEntgG   .
IF_EX_ISH_EDI_WORKLIST         I MODIFY_ALV_DATA               Modififies Data of ALV Display                              .
IF_EX_ISH_ERROR_DRG            I TEST                          DRG Is Checked for Error DRG                                .
IF_EX_ISH_EXTPATID             I TEST                          Test External Patient ID                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF01           I RNF01_APP_CHANGE              Fill FORM Structure RNF01 for Provisional Appointment       .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF01           I RNF01_CHANGE                  Change FORM Structure RNF01                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF01           I RNF01_EBILL_CHANGE            Fill FORM Structure RNF01 for Estimated Invoice             .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF02           I RNF02_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF02                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF03           I RNF031_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF031                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF03           I RNF032_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Strucure RNF032                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF03           I RNF03_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF03                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF04           I RNF04_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF04                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF05           I RNF05_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF05                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF06           I RNF06_AMB_CHANGE              Fill FORM Structure RNF06 for Outpatient Movements          .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF06           I RNF06_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF06 for Inpatient Admission           .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF07           I RNF071_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF071                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF07           I RNF072_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF072                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF07           I RNF073_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF073                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF07           I RNF07_AMB_CHANGE              Fill FORM Structure RNF07 for Outpatient Case               .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF07           I RNF07_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF07 for Inpatient (Day Patient) Case  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF08           I RNF081_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF081                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF08           I RNF082_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF082                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF08           I RNF08_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF08                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF09           I RNF09_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF09                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF10           I RNF10_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF10                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF111_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF111                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF112_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF112                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF113_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF113                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF114_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF114                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF115_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF115                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF116_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNF116                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF116_CHANGE_SAMRE           Fill FORM Structure RNF116 (Collective Invoice)             .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF11           I RNF11_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF111                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF12           I RNF12_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF12                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF13           I RNF13_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF13                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF14           I RNF14_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF14                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF15           I RNF15_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF15                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF16           I RNF16_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF16                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF17           I RNF17_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF17                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF18           I RNF18_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF18                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF30           I RNF30_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF30                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF30           I RNF62_CHANGE                  Chang Form Structure RNF62                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF30           I RNF64_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF64                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF34           I RNF34_CHANGE                  Change FOrm Structure RNF34                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF35           I RNF35_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF35                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF36           I RNF36_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF36                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF37           I RNF37_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF37                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF38           I RNF38_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF38                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF40           I RNF40_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF40                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF41           I RNF41_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF41                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF44           I RNF44_CHANGE                  Change FOrm Structure RNF44                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF47           I RNF47_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF47                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF48           I RNF48_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF48                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF49           I RNF49_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF49                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF54           I RNF54_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF54                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF55           I RNF55_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF55                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF56           I RNF56_CHANGE                  Change Form Stucture RNF56                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF57           I RNF57_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF57                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF58           I RNF58_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF58                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF59           I RNF59_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF59                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF60           I RNF60_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF60                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF61           I RNF61_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF61                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF67           I RNF67_CHANGE                  Change Form Structure RNF67                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNF68           I RNF68_CHANGE                  Fill FORM Structure RNF68                                   .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNFKSR          I RNFKSR_CHANGE                 Fill FORM Structure RNFKSR                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_FILL_RNFP2S          I RNFP2SE_CHANGE                Fill FORM Structure RNFP2SE                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_GET_DIAGNOSIS        I GET_ADDITIONAL_DIAGNOSIS      Determine Additional Diagnoses                              .
IF_EX_ISH_INIT_MD_STATUS       I INIT_STATUS_MED_DOCU          Initialize Case Status of Medical Basic Documentation       .
IF_EX_ISH_INSREL_CASE_SAVE     I CHANGES_NCIR                  Which Data Has Changed in NCIR                              .
IF_EX_ISH_INVOICE_CHECK        I INVOICE_CHECK                 Check Invoice Creation                                      .
IF_EX_ISH_INV_CANCEL_CHK_1     I CANCEL_ALLOWED_CHECK          Check if Invoice Cancellation is Allowed.                   .
IF_EX_ISH_IR_DEFAULT_UNTGR     I IR_DEFAULT_UNTGR              Fill Default Value for Field "untgr" from Current IR        .
IF_EX_ISH_MD_PROOF             I CHECK                         Check Consistency                                           .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_CONS_CO_PREP      I CHANGE                        Change Line Item                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_DOCTYPE           I FIND_DOCTYPE                  Determine Procurement/Document Type                         .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_EXT_INQUIRY       I GET_MATREQ                    Start External Search                                       .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_MAT_PRICE         I DETERM_MATPRICE               Determination of the Material Price                         .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_STORL2MMDOC       I CHECK                         Check Event when Creating/Changing Material Requisition     .
IF_EX_ISH_MM_STORL2MMDOC       I PRE_UPD                       Event Before Posting MM Document                            .
IF_EX_ISH_NONSPECIFIC_DIAG     I TEST                          Test for Non-Specificity                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_NONSPECIFIC_PROC     I TEST                          Test for Non-Specificity                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_NPAP_TO_NPAT         I MOVE_NPAP_TO_NPAT             Reassign Data of a Provisional Patient to a Real Patient    .
IF_EX_ISH_NPDRG2_FINAL_CHK     I FINAL_SCREEN_CHECK            Check All Data that Is Relevant for Grouping                .
IF_EX_ISH_NPR2_RNF01           I RNF01_CHANGE                  Change RNF01                                                .
IF_EX_ISH_NREDOMA              I CHECK                         Check Customer-Specific Data                                .
IF_EX_ISH_NREDOMA              I GET                           Read Customer-Specific Data                                 .
IF_EX_ISH_NREDOMA              I MODIFY                        Processing of Customer-Specific Data                        .
IF_EX_ISH_NV2000_CASTYPCHG     I TEST                          Test Patient Data at Case Type Change                       .
IF_EX_ISH_NV2000_PAI           I TEST                          Test Data of Single Subscreens (EnjoySAP Admission)         .
IF_EX_ISH_NV2000_PAI_COMPL     I TEST                          Test Complete Data of Clinical Process Builder              .
IF_EX_ISH_NV2000_PBO           I MODIFY_DATA                   Preset Subscreen Fields by Changing Proposed Data           .
IF_EX_ISH_NV2000_REN_TABPG     I RENAME_TABPAGE                Dynamic Assignment of NV2000 Tab Page Texts                 .
IF_EX_ISH_P21_TRANSFER         I GET_P21_ENT                   Individual Data Determination P21 File ENGELTE              .
IF_EX_ISH_P21_TRANSFER         I GET_P21_FAB                   Individual Data Determination §21 File FAB                  .
IF_EX_ISH_P21_TRANSFER         I GET_P21_FALL                  Individual Data Determination §21 File FALL                 .
IF_EX_ISH_P21_TRANSFER         I GET_P21_ICD                   Individual Data Determination §21 File ICD                  .
IF_EX_ISH_P21_TRANSFER         I GET_P21_OPS                   Individual Data Determination §21 File OPS                  .
IF_EX_ISH_PAT_HTML_HEADER      I CHANGE                        Reorganize Patient Header Data                              .
IF_EX_ISH_PAYDIST_INSREL       I DETERMINE_COVERAGE            Determination of the Coverage of Days                       .
IF_EX_ISH_PAYDIST_INSREL       I REQUIREMENTS_HEADER           Specific Requirements for Contract Schemes (Header Level)   .
IF_EX_ISH_PAYDIST_INSREL       I REQUIREMENTS_ITEM             Specific Requirements for Contract Schemes (Item Level)     .
IF_EX_ISH_PAYDIST_INSREL       I SERVICE_FILTER                Service Filter for Contract Scheme                          .
IF_EX_ISH_PAYDIST_INSREL       I SORT_INSURANCES               Insurance Relationship Sort Sequence                        .
IF_EX_ISH_PICKLIST_000001      I HEADER_CHANGE                 Change Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_ISH_PICKLIST_000001      I ITEM_CHANGE                   Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_ISH_PICKLIST_000001      I LIST_HEAD                     Define List Header of Pick List                             .
IF_EX_ISH_PICKLIST_000002      I GOODS_ISSUE_CHANGE            Change Goods Issues                                         .
IF_EX_ISH_PREREG_CHANGE        I EXIT_STATUS_SET               Change Data (e.g. Waiting List Data) of Clinical Order      .
IF_EX_ISH_PRICING_FIELDS       I FIELDS_FILL                   Fill Customer-Specific Pricing Fields                       .
IF_EX_ISH_PRINT_INVOICE        I PRINT_STRUCTURES_MODIFY       Modify Print Structures                                     .
IF_EX_ISH_PRINT_OPEN_FORM      I OPTIONS_CHANGE                Changen SAPScript Options for OPEN_FORM                     .
IF_EX_ISH_PROCEDURE_ADJUST     I OFFICIAL_CREATE               Generate an Official Procedure Code from a Qty-Based Code   .
IF_EX_ISH_PROCEDURE_CHECK      I PROCEDURE_CHECK               Check Procedure Data                                        .
IF_EX_ISH_PROCEDURE_PROPOS     I PROPOSALS_CHANGE              Change Default Values for Procedures (Date, Indicators, etc).
IF_EX_ISH_PROCEDURE_SORT       I PROCEDURE_SORT                Sort Procedures of a Case for Display                       .
IF_EX_ISH_READ_TNFAS           I READ_FAS                      Determination of a Department Status                        .
IF_EX_ISH_RESPIRATION_PROC     I TEST                          Definition SP Codes for Mechanical Ventilation              .
IF_EX_ISH_REV_ASSIGNMENT       I REV_ASSIGM_SET                Disable Revenue Assignment for Invoice Item                 .
IF_EX_ISH_RNZUZBI1_SORT        I CASES_SORT                    Sort Cases to Be Processed                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICEFORM          I CONVERT_INPUT                 Convert Form Input                                          .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICEFORM          I INIT_FORM                     Initialize HTML Form                                        .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICEFORM          I INIT_FORM_TITLE               Initialize Form Title                                       .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICE_DPD          I FIND_DEPARTMENTAL_PER_DIEM    IS-H: Determine Departmental Per Diem                       .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICE_ENTRY        I MODIFY_INPUT                  Modification of Data Input                                  .
IF_EX_ISH_SERVICE_MOVEMENT     I MOVEMENT_DATA_DETERMINE       Determine Movement Data for a Service                       .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I BUILD_TREE                    Case Revision - Build Tree for Display                      .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I CHANGE_DESTINATION_FIELDS     Case Revision - Change Parameters for Target Objects        .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I CHECK_DATA                    Case Revision - Check Results                               .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I CLEAN_UP                      Case Revision - Processing after COMMIT                     .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I MODIFY_DATA                   Case Revision - Process Data                                .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I SELECT_DATA                   Case Revision - Data Selection                              .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I SET_EXPAND                    Case Revision - Expand Behavior                             .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CUS            I SET_TREE_PARAMETER            Case Revision - Selection Behavior                          .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CV             I BUILD_TREE                    Case Revision - Build Tree for Display                      .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CV             I CHECK_DATA                    Case Revision - Check Results                               .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CV             I CLEAN_UP                      Case Revision - Processing after COMMIT                     .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CV             I MODIFY_DATA                   Case Revision - Process Data                                .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_CV             I SELECT_DATA                   Case Revision - Data Selection                              .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I BUILD_TREE                    Case Revision - Build Tree for Display                      .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I CHECK_DATA                    Case Revision - Check Results                               .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I CLEAN_UP                      Case Revision - Processing after COMMIT                     .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I MODIFY_DATA                   Case Revision - Process Data                                .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I SELECT_DATA                   Case Revision - Data Selection                              .
IF_EX_ISH_SHIFT_PROPMED        I TREE_INFO                     Case Revision - Transfer Information from Tree              .
IF_EX_ISH_SPECIALCODE_PROC     I TEST                          Test for Special ICPM Code of a Procedure                   .
IF_EX_ISH_SURGERY_DRG          I TEST                          DRG Is Checked for Surgery DRG                              .
IF_EX_ISH_TIMESLOT_CHANGE      I CHECK_NEW_TIMESLOT            Check New Time Slot when Appointment Moved                  .
IF_EX_ISH_TIMESLOT_CHANGE      I MODIFY_TIMESLOTS              Change the Time Slots for the Open Time Slot Search         .
IF_EX_ISH_TIMESLOT_TXT         I MODIFY_TIMESLOT_TEXT          Change Text of Time Slot/Appointment                        .
IF_EX_ISH_TREATMENT_DETERM     I TREATMENT_DETERMINATION       Determine Treatment Type                                    .
IF_EX_ISH_UNIRETCASE_PROC      I CHANGE_PROC                   Determination of the Procedures to Be Displayed             .
IF_EX_ISH_UPGRADE_DRG          I TEST                          DRG Is Checked for Higher Valuated DRG                      .
IF_EX_ISH_VRGNG_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check the Business Transaction                              .
IF_EX_ISH_VRGNG_SERV_BILL      I CHECK_SERV                    Check if Services Allowed for Billing                       .
IF_EX_ISH_WP_PREREG_VIEW       I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Customer-Specific Data Display in Preregistration Views     .
IF_EX_ISH_WP_PREREG_VIEW       I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Customer-Specifc Function Execution in Preregistration Views.
IF_EX_ISH_WP_VIEW_FUNC         I FUNCTION_CALL                 Customer-Specific Function Execution in CWS Views           .
IF_EX_ISH_WP_VIEW_TITLE        I MODIFY_TITLE                  Change Title                                                .
IF_EX_ISH_WP_VW123_COLUMN      I MODIFY                        Modify Occupancy/Arrival/Departure Views                    .
IF_EX_ISH_WP_VW123_FUNC        I FUNCTION                      Customer-Specific Function Execution in Occupancy Views     .
IF_EX_ISMSECONTRACTACTIVAT     I SET_DISPLAY_DATE              Set Trial Period in Order                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_ADDR_CHECK_LIST      I CITY_OUTPUT                   Change Display for Cities                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_ADDR_CHECK_LIST      I POBOX_OUTPUT                  Change Display for PO Boxes                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_ADDR_CHECK_LIST      I STREET_OUTPUT                 Change Display for Streets                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_ADDR_SYNC            I ADDRESS_AFTER_SYNC            Transfer Address for Synchronization                        .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ADCONT_VALIDATE   I TRIGGER_VALIDATION            Trigger Ad Content Validation                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ADSIZE_SPLIT      I GET_PRICE_REL_UOM             Determine Price-Relevant Unit of Measure                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ADSIZE_SPLIT      I GET_SPLIT_MESSAGE_TYPE        Message Type for Ad Size Distribution Messages              .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ADSIZE_SPLIT      I GET_TOTAL_AD_SIZE             Calculate Ad Size                                           .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_AGENCY_ADVERT_REL I CHECK_ORDER_BLOCK             Check Order Lock                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BILLDOC_BAPI      I BAPI_GETDET_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameter in BAPI Used to Read Billing Document .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BILLDOC_BAPI      I BAPI_GETLIST_ADD_SELECTS      Additional Selections in BAPI Used to Select Billing Docs   .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BOOKUNIT_BAPI     I BAPI_GETDET_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameters in BAPI for Reading Booking Unit     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BUILD_SERIE       I BUILD_SERIE                   Series Creation for the Billing Dataset                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BUILD_SERIE       I BUILD_SERIE_ALL               Cross-Item Series Creation for the Billing Dataset          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BUILD_SERIE       I GET_SERIES_RULE               Series Rule Determination for the Billing Dataset           .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BU_ENHANCEMENT    I FILL_BILLING_INTERFACE        Enter Profit Center and Cost Center in Billing Item         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BU_ENHANCEMENT    I FILL_REVENUE_RECOGNITION_MAM  Enter PRCTR and KOSTL in Revenue Object Document Item       .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_BU_ENHANCEMENT    I FILL_REVENUE_RECOGNITION_SD   Enter PRCTR and KOSTL in SD Table                           .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_COAEXT_BAPI       I BEFORE_SAVE                   Enhance AdMgmtCOAExt.Save Interface                         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_COAEXT_BAPI       I FILTEROBJECTS                 Enter Customer Filter Objects from Contract Header          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_COAEXT_BAPI       I WITH_TEXTS                    Export New/Changed Contracts with Short Texts?              .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_COA_BAPI          I BAPI_GETLIST_ADD_SELECTS      Additional Selections in BAPI Used to Select Contracts      .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTCOMP_BAPI     I BAPI_GETDET_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameters in BAPI for Reading Content Comp.    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTCOMP_BAPI     I BAPI_GETLIST_ADD_SELECTS      Fill Output Parameters in BAPI for Reading Content Comp.    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTRACT          I COMPRESS_KOLNR                Map Several Access Numbers to a KOMP Substructure           .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTRACT          I FILL_PRICE_SETTLEMENT         Fill Price Fields in Contract Settlement                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTRACT          I SCALE_BASE_COMM               Fill Price Fields from Scale Base Contract                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTRACT_NUMBER   I GET_NEXT_NUMBER               Determine Next Contract Number                              .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CONTR_ASSIGNMENT  I UPDATE_ASSIGNMENT             Change Contract Assignment                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_CVV_HANDLING      I CLEAR_CVV_AFTER_AUTH          Delete Card Verification Value Following Authorization      .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I CONVERT_DL_TO_USER_TIMEZONE   Convert Order Deadline to User's Time Zone                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I DEADLINE_ACTION_ON_CANCEL     Check Order Deadline if a Cancellation Takes Place          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I DEADLINE_ACTION_ON_CHANGES    Check Order Deadline if Changes Are Made                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I DETERMINE_DEADLINE            Calculate Order Deadline                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I DETERMINE_DL_DISABLE_BUTTONS  Deactivate Buttons                                          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I DETERMINE_DL_DISABLE_FIELDS   Determine Fields to be Locked                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I ENABLE_DL_STATUS_CHAR         Modify Status Field Attribute                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I GET_DL_DATA_FROM_SCREEN       Import Order Deadline Data                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I REFRESH_ACCESS_DATA           Refresh Buffered Tables                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_DEADLINE_MGMT     I SET_DL_DATA_TO_SCREEN         Display Order Deadline Data                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_FI_DOC_ENHANCEMNT I PASS_ADV_TO_BILLINGDOC        Transfer Advertiser in Agency Order to Billing Document     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_FI_DOC_ENHANCEMNT I PASS_ADV_TO_FIDOC             Transfer Advertiser in Agency Order to FI                   .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_FI_DOC_ENHANCEMNT I SET_SPLIT_CRIT_AT_CNTRCT_SETTLPopulate Split Criterion for Contract Settlement            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_HEIGHT_ROUNDING   I APPLY_ROUNDING_RULES          Use rounding rule                                           .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_HOLIDAY           I RETRIEVE_HOLIDAY_ID           Read Public Holiday Information                             .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_HOLIDAY           I RETRIEVE_HOLIDAY_TEXT         Read Public Holiday Text                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_IAC_GET_LINE      I ORDER_LIST_LINE_GET           Define Selected Line                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_IND_SECTOR_ADV    I TRANSFER_INDUSTRY_SECTOR      Transfer Industry Sector for Item to Advertiser Assignment  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_INHK_KLEV1        I CHANGE_TABLE                  Change Entire Table                                         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_INHK_KLEV1        I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Content Component Text                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ITA               I AFTER_AD_DESIGN               After Accessing Text Entry/Ad Design                        .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_JHA6_SELECT       I ORDER_ITEM_SELECT             Select Order Items                                          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MAN_SL_GENERATION I ACTIVATE_BAPI_FIELDS          Check Whether Manual Schedule Lines Can Be Modified         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MAN_SL_GENERATION I ACTIVATE_SCREENFIELDS         Perform Screen Modification                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MAN_SL_GENERATION I SET_CHANGEABILITY             Allow Content Components to be Modified                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MAN_SL_GENERATION I SET_MAN_SCHED_LINE_CHANGABLE  Allow Manual Schedule Lines to be Modified                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MIN_MAX_RULE      I CHECK_MIN_MAX_SIZE            Check Min./Max.Sizes                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MIN_MAX_RULE      I CHECK_MIN_MAX_SIZE_ERROR      Check Whether Min./Max Size is Incorrect                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_MIN_MAX_RULE      I REFRESH_CLASS_ATTRIBUTES      Delete Class Attributes                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_OL_TIMESLICE      I GET_TIMESLICE_TEXT            Read Text on Time Slice                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDEREXT_BAPI     I BAPI_SAVE_EXTENSION_IN_FILL   Enhance AdMgmtSOExt.Save Interface                          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDEREXT_BAPI     I FILTEROBJECTS                 Fill Customer Filter Objects                                .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_CHANGE_EXTENSION_IN_CHECKCheck Input Parameter in BAPI Used to Change an Order       .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_CHANGE_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameter in BAPI Used to Change an Order       .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_CREATE_EXTENSION_IN_CHECKCheck Input Parameter in BAPI Used to Create an Order       .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_CREATE_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameter in BAPI Used to Create an Order       .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_GETDET_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameter in BAPI Used to Read an Order         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_GETLIST_ADD_SELECTS      Additional Selections in BAPI Used to Select Orders         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI        I BAPI_MAP2I_ALL                In BAPI for Mapping from External to Internal Structures    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI_MAP    I MAP2I_ADVERT_ASS2ISZ          Map Advertiser Assignment                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_BAPI_MAP    I MAP2I_ITEM_OL2APO             Map Online Item                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_PRICEGROUP  I GET_ADV_PRICE_GROUP           Read Advertiser Price Group From the Global Attributes      .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_PRICEGROUP  I GET_ADV_PRICE_GROUP_FROM_MD   Read Price Group From the Advertiser Master Data            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_ORDER_PRICEGROUP  I SET_PRICE_GROUP               Write Current Price Group in the Global Attributes          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_PRICING_ENH       I FILL_PRICING_INTERFACE        Make Entries in Additional Fields in the Pricing Interface  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REQMT_ELEMENT     I CHECK_FULFILLMENT             Check Whether Contract Requirement Element is Fulfilled     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REQMT_ELEMENT     I GET_REQ_EL_FROM_SCREEN        Transfer Value From Subscreen                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REQMT_ELEMENT     I GET_REQ_EL_FROM_SCREEN_AI     Value Transfer from Subscreen for Ad Insert                 .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REQMT_ELEMENT     I SET_REQ_EL_TO_SCREEN          Transfer Value to Subscreen                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REQMT_ELEMENT     I SET_REQ_EL_TO_SCREEN_AI       Value Transfer to Subscreen for Ad Insert                   .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I CHANGE_ACCOUNTING             Change Account Assignment Object in the Billing Document    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I CONDITION_AMOUNT              Change Condition Amount for Revenue Distribution            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Declare Customer Subscreen                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I ON_CUSTOMER_PAI               After Customer Subscreen PAI                                .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I ON_CUSTOMER_PBO               Before Customer Subscreen PBO                               .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I ON_READ                       When the Revenue Object Document is Imported                .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I ON_RENUMBER                   During Number Assignment for the Reference Document         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_REVOBJ            I ON_SAVE                       When Saving the Revenue Object Document                     .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SCR_MOD_ADV       I COLLECT_INVISIBLE_FIELDS_ADV  Collect Field Names for Invisible Fields (Advertiser Screen).
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SCR_MOD_ADV       I COLLECT_INVISIBLE_FIELDS_ITEM Collect Field Names for Invisible Fields  (Item Details)    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SERIES_RULE_ENH   I CHECK_WEEKDAY_ASSIGNMENT      Check Weekday Assignment                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SLS_AGT_CONTR_DET I FILL_DETAIL                   Copy Detailed Data: Enter Free Attributes                   .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SORTWORD_GENERATI I DISPLAY_SORTWORD_ITEM_LEVEL   Display Sort Word at Item Level                             .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SORTWORD_GENERATI I GENERATE_SORTWORD             Generate Sort Word                                          .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_SORTWORD_GENERATI I GET_SORTWORD_CUSTOMIZING      Read Customizing Settings for the Sort Word                 .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_UNIT_CONVERSION   I CALCULATE_ADSIZE_IN_UOM_LINES Convert to Lines                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_UNIT_CONVERSION   I UNIT_CONVERSION               Units conversion                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_VOUCHER           I CHANGE_DATA_VOUCHER           Modify Voucher Shipping Data                                .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_WEB_PUBLICATION   I GET_WEBPUB_FROM_BU            Define Whether Web Publication Can Be Modified              .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_WEB_PUBLICATION   I MOVE_WEBPUB_IND_TO_SCH_LINES  Transfer Web Publication Indicator to Schedule Line         .
IF_EX_ISM_AM_WEB_PUBLICATION   I MOVE_WEBPUB_IND_TO_TECH_SYS   Transfer Web Publication Indicator for the Technical System .
IF_EX_ISM_AREA_SEGMENT         I GET_SEGMENT_FROM_CONTRACT     Determine Segment According to Contract                     .
IF_EX_ISM_ATTRIBUTE_MAP        I ATTRIBUTE_MAP_BILL_DOC        Attribute Mapping for SD Billing Document                   .
IF_EX_ISM_BPEXT_BAPI           I BAPI_SAVE_EXTENSION_IN_FILL   Enhance interface of ISMBusinessPartnerExt.Save             .
IF_EX_ISM_BPEXT_BAPI           I FILTEROBJECTS                 Fill Customer Filter Objects                                .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_ADDRESS_MAP       I ADDRESS_ISM_TO_SAPBP          Map Address Fields from IS-M to SAP BP                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_ADDRESS_MAP       I ADDRESS_SAPBP_TO_ISM          Map Address Fields from SAP BP to IS-M                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I BAPI_BEFORE_IDOC_INPUT_DEBITORIn BAPI Before Creating/Changing the Customer               .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I BAPI_CHANGE_EXTENSION_IN_CHECKCheck Input Parameters in BAPI for Changing Bus. Partners   .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I BAPI_CREATE_EXTENSION_IN_CHECKCheck Input Parameters in BAPI for Creating Bus. Partners   .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I BAPI_GETDET_EXTENSION_OUT_FILLFill Output Parameters in BAPI for Reading Bus. Partners    .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I BAPI_GETLIST_ADD_SELECTS      Additional Selections in BAPI for Selecting Bus. Partners   .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_BAPI              I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          IS-M business partner created or changed                    .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_CREATE            I DIALOG_PREPARE                Format Subscreen Name, Address, Communication Data          .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_CREDIT_MASTER     I FILL_CREDIT_MASTER            Fill Credit Control Data                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I ADDRESS_MAP                   Address Mapping                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I CRED_EKORG_DETERMINE          Purchasing Organization for Vendor                          .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I CRED_GROUP_NR_DETERMINE       Grouping and Partner Number for Vendor                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I CRED_ROLE_DETERMINE           Role for Vendor                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I CRED_TYPE_DETERMINE           Business Partner Category for Vendor                        .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I DEB_GROUP_DETERMINE           Grouping for Customer                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I DEB_ROLE_DETERMINE            Role for Customer                                           .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I DEB_TYPE_DETERMINE            Business Partner Category for Customer                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTBP00_FILL                  Enter General IS-M Data                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTEUWVV_FILL                 Enter Sales Area-Dependent Retailer Data                    .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTEUWV_FILL                  Enter General Retailer Data                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTVERM_FILL                  Enter Commission Recipient Data                             .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTVSG_FILL                   Enter SC Data                                               .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JGTZUST_FILL                  Enter Carrier Data                                          .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEB_CRED_MIG      I JJTVM_FILL                    Enter Sales Area-Dependent Media Customer Data              .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_DEFAULT_VALUE     I SET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Preassign Fields in SAP Business Partner                    .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_SEARCH            I FCODE_EXECUTE                 Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_SEARCH            I STATUS_ACTIVATE               Activate Interface Status                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_TELNR_EXCHNGE     I BAS_CONSNR_DETERMINE          Determine Sequence Number for Telephone Number in IS-M      .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_TELNR_EXCHNGE     I ISM_TO_BAS_CONVERSION         Convert Telephone Number from IS-M to BAS Format            .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_TELNR_EXCHNGE     I TELNR_REMARK_GET              Define Names for Private and Office Number                  .
IF_EX_ISM_BP_TELNR_SPLITT      I SPLITT_TEL_NUMBER             Split Telephone Number                                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BSP_ACTION           I HANDLE_ACTION                 Process Action                                              .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLEPP_ACCDOC     I ACCIT_CHANGE                  Change ACCIT                                                .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLE_PP_920       I ACC_ITEM_CHANGE               Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLE_PP_920       I FIELDCAT_CHANGE               Change Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLE_PP_920       I TEXTFIELDS_ASSIGN             Assign Text Fields to Split Attributes                      .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLE_PP_ACCIT     I ACCIT_FIELDVAL_SET            Set ACCIT Field Value                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_BYTITLE_PP_ACCIT     I ACCIT_RELEVANCE_CHECK         Check Relevance of an ACCIT Line                            .
IF_EX_ISM_CHECK_REQUEST        I CHECK_REQUEST_NUMBER          Check Request Number for Returns and Subs.Deliveries        .
IF_EX_ISM_CHECK_REQUEST        I CHECK_REQUEST_NUMBER_DIALOG   Check Request Number for Returns and Sub.Dels in Dialog     .
IF_EX_ISM_CHECK_REQUEST        I CHECK_UNSOLDS_ADD_DIALOG      Additional Checks for Returns and Sub.Dels for Dialog Proc. .
IF_EX_ISM_CHECK_REQUEST        I DO_ADDITIONAL_CHECKS_UNSOLDS  Implement Additional Checks for Returns and Sub.Dels        .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I BP_SEARCH_WITH_DOCNR          Search for Business Partners in Your Own Document Types     .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I BUSINESS_PARTNER_SEARCH       Detailed Search for Business Partners (Extra Button)        .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I CONVERT_DOCNR_TO_ORDERNR      Convert Document Number to Order Number                     .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I DOCUMENT_TYPES_MODIFY         Change Possible Document Types for Search                   .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I FILTER_SEARCH_RESULT          Filter Search Result                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I HITLIST_PREPARE_FOR_WORKSPACE Enhance and Prepare Hit List (Workspace)                    .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_BP_SEARCH        I PRELIMINARY_BUSINESS_PRTN_SRCHAdvance Business Partner Search (Pre-Defined Standrd Search).
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_EWHV_BSP         I GET_NAVVIEW_PROFILE           Determine Profile Assigned to Data Environment              .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_EWHV_BSP         I GET_REPRESENTATION            Adjust Display                                              .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_NAVVIEW          I GET_TEMP_PROFILE              Profile for Variant                                         .
IF_EX_ISM_CIC_NAVVIEW          I GET_VARIANTTAB                Determine Variant List and Default Variant                  .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_COLLECTIONDATE            Determine Collection Date for BP                            .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_DEMAND                    Select JKSDDEMAND Records                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_ISSUE_DATE                Determine Collection Date for Issue                         .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_SORTED_ISSUES             Return Media Issues in Sequence (New)                       .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_SORTED_MEDIA_ISSUES       Return Media Issues in Sequence                             .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I GET_UNLOADING_POINT           Select an Unloading Point                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I SET_ADD_FIELDS_BAG            Additional Fields JKSDCOLLECTBAG                            .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I SET_ADD_FIELDS_ISSUE          Additional Fields JKSDCOLLECTISSUE                          .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I SET_FIELDS_ALV_BAG            Fill ALV Structure BAG + ISSUE                              .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I SET_ISSUEDATE                 Adjust Append Fields in JKSDISSUEDATE                       .
IF_EX_ISM_COLLECTION           I SET_UNSOLDNUMBER              Set Field for Unsold Number                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I CUSTOMER_SELECTION            Execute Customer-Specific Selection                         .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SET_CONTRACT_POS              Format Contract Item                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SET_GEOUNIT                   Format Geographical Unit                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SET_NAME                      Format Business Partner                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SET_PRODUCT                   Format Product                                              .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SHOW_SELECTION_ON_SCREEN      Display Selection Result on Screen                          .
IF_EX_ISM_CONTRACT_NAVI        I SHOW_SELECTION_ON_SCREEN_PHASEDisplay Selection Result for Phase Shipping on Screen       .
IF_EX_ISM_CRM_CAMPAIGNMGNT     I FILL_SORT_DATA_MAM            Templates: Enter M/AM Sorting Data                          .
IF_EX_ISM_CRM_CAMPAIGNMGNT     I FILL_SORT_DATA_MSD            Templates: Enter M/SD Sorting Data                          .
IF_EX_ISM_CRM_CAMPAIGNMGNT     I FILL_SORT_INFO_MAM            Templates: Define M/AM Sorting                              .
IF_EX_ISM_CRM_CAMPAIGNMGNT     I FILL_SORT_INFO_MSD            Templates: Define M/SD Sorting                              .
IF_EX_ISM_CRM_CAMPAIGNMGNT     I GET_COMPONENTS                Components Used                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I APPEND_VARIANT_PARAMS         Append Own Criteria to Selection Variant                    .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Change ALV Field Catalog                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I CHANGE_OUTLINES               Change ALV Output Lines                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I CHECK_CHANGERULE              Check Change Rule (PAI)                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I EXPORT_CHANGERULE             Return Change Rule from Customer-Specific Subscreen         .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I GET_LIST_INSTANCE             Get Object of Type CL_ISM_SD_LISTDEMANDCHANGE               .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I GET_PARAMS                    Get Selection Parameters                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I GET_SELECTION_SUBSCREEN       Return Selection Subscreen                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I GET_SUBSCREENS                Return List of Customer Subscreens                          .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I GET_VIEWER_INSTANCE           Get Object of Type CL_ISM_SD_VIEWERDEMANDCHANGE             .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I IMPORT_CHANGERULE             Copy Change Rule for Customer Subscreen                     .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Selection and Change Rule                        .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I PREPARE_CHANGERULE            Prepare Change Rule (PBO)                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I SELECT_REFERENCE_ISSUE        Choose Reference Issue from List of Possibilities           .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDCHANGE         I SET_PARAMS                    Set Selection Parameters                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMANDSET_BAPI       I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Quantity Calculations Before Update                         .
IF_EX_ISM_DEMAND_SET_ROLE      I SET_DISPLAY_ROLE              Assign Default Business Partner Role for Display            .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_APPLICATION_ID            Define Application                                          .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_CLASSES_FOR_BUS_OBJ       Define LOIO and PHIO Class for Business Object              .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_CONTEXT_CLASS             Define Context Class                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_FOLDER_CLASS              Define LOIO Class for Folder                                .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_LINK_RANGE                Define Connection Area                                      .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_CLASS_DETERM      I GET_URL_CLASSES               Define LOIO and PHIO Class for URL                          .
IF_EX_ISM_DM_DOCUMENTS         I CARRY_OUT_ACTION              Perform Actions for New, Modified, Deleted Documents        .
IF_EX_ISM_FORECAST             I GET_TABLE_DATA                Determine Data for Reference Issues                         .
IF_EX_ISM_FORECAST             I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTON            Adds Button to Toolbar                                      .
IF_EX_ISM_FORECAST             I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           Reacts to User-Defined Buttons                              .
IF_EX_ISM_GENERATIONGROUP      I GET_GENERATION_GROUP          Determine Generation Group                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_GENERIC_SHIP_MSG     I CREATE                        Create Additional Shipping Problem Message for Complaint    .
IF_EX_ISM_HH_ASSIGN            I SET_HH_VALUES                 Determine Household for Address                             .
IF_EX_ISM_IDCODES              I CHECK_MAIN_IDCODE_CHANGE      Check Whether Main ID Code can be Changed                   .
IF_EX_ISM_IDCODES              I MODIFY_IDCODES_BEFORE_SAVING  Change ID Code List Before Saving                           .
IF_EX_ISM_IF_SETTLEMENT        I ENHANCE_INTERFACE_RECORDS     Change/Add Records to Settlement Interface                  .
IF_EX_ISM_IPM_MAP_BILL_DOC     I MAP_BILL_DOC                  Make Entries in OR Data Collector for Billing Item          .
IF_EX_ISM_ISSUE_DATES_SET      I EXECUTE_BEFORE_CREATE         Execute Before Creating Media Issue in Issue Sequence       .
IF_EX_ISM_ISSUE_GENERATION     I EXECUTE_AFTER_CREATE          Execute After Creating Media Issue in Issue Sequence        .
IF_EX_ISM_MAP_CONTRACT         I MAP_CONTRACTS                 Maps Contracts                                              .
IF_EX_ISM_MEDIA_MIX            I SET_DESCRIPTION               IS-M: Assign Long and Short Text for Mix                    .
IF_EX_ISM_MPS_ADR_ASSEMBLE     I GET_DOUBLE_ADDR_LINE          Format Two-Line Address                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_MPS_ADR_ASSEMBLE     I GET_SINGLE_ADDR_LINE          Format One-Line Address                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_MSDORDER_CAMP        I PAI                           Exit at PAI                                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_MSDORDER_CAMP        I PBO                           Exit at PBO                                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_MSDORDER_CAMP        I PREPARE                       Assign Defaults                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_MSD_CRMLOCATOR       I GET_VALUE                     Value Determination for Field                               .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDER                I CHANGE_SCHEDULE_DATE          Change Schedule Line Date                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDER                I ORDER_GENERATED               Order Generated                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDER                I ROUND_FULL_BUNDLE_CHANGE_ORDERRound to Full Bundles When Changing Orders                  .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDER                I ROUND_FULL_BUNDLE_CREATE_ORDERRound to Full Bundles When Generating Orders                .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDER                I SET_WISHDATE_ORDER_GENERATION Define Requested Delivery Date During Order Generation      .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERBOOK            I AT_SELECT                     Enter Data in Own Fields                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERBOOK            I CHANGE_PODATE_PHASEMODEL      Change Purchase Order Date for Phase Model                  .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERBOOK            I CHANGE_QUANTITY               Change Planned Purchase Order Quantity                      .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERBOOK            I SET_DIFF_BOUNDARIES           Set Difference Values (for Icon)                            .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I ATTACH                        Append ALV List to Container                                .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check for Data Changed by User                              .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I CLEAR_BUFFERS                 Clear Internal Buffer                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I DISPLAY                       Display ALV List                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I EXECUTE_OK_CODE               Execute User Command                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I EXECUTE_REFRESH               Refresh ALV List                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I GET_CHANGE_SUBSCREEN          Return List of Customer Change Subscreens                   .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I GET_JOB_NAME                  Get Name of Background Job                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I GET_LIST_DATA                 Get Order List                                              .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I GET_PARAMS                    Get Selection Parameters                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I GET_SELECTION_SUBSCREEN       Return Customer-Specific Selection Subscreen                .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I IS_SAVE_REQUIRED              Have user changes been made?                                .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I REGISTER_REFRESH              Flag ALV List for Refresh                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I SAVE                          Save Changed Data                                           .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I SET_MODE                      Set Display/Change Mode                                     .
IF_EX_ISM_ORDERCHANGE          I SET_PARAMS                    Set Selection Parameters                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_PARTNER              I CHANGE_HEAD                   Change Partners at Header Data Level                        .
IF_EX_ISM_PARTNER              I CHANGE_POS                    Change Partners at Item Level                               .
IF_EX_ISM_PHASEMDL_PROM        I GET_DELIVERY_DATE             Define Shipping Date                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_PHASEMDL_PROM        I GET_HEADER_DATA               Header Data for Phase Model                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_PLANT                I SET_DATE_FOR_WEEKDAY          Set Date Relevant for Weekday Determination                 .
IF_EX_ISM_PLM_JPC1_ADD         I CREATE_ADDITIONAL_OBJECTS     Create Additional Objects                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_PLM_JPC1_ADD         I SET_CONTROL_PARAMETERS_MPM    Set Control Parameters for Creating Media Product Master    .
IF_EX_ISM_PORDER               I BEFORE_PO_CHANGE              Before Changing Purchase Orders                             .
IF_EX_ISM_PORDER               I BEFORE_PO_CREATE              Before Creating Purchase Orders                             .
IF_EX_ISM_PRIORITY             I CHANGE                        Change Delivery Priorities                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_PRIORITY             I DEFINE                        Define Delivery Priorities                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_PRODUCT_DATES        I INITSHIPDATE_DEFAULT_SET      Set Default Value for Initial Shipping Date                 .
IF_EX_ISM_PRODUCT_DATES        I INTERRUPTDATE_CHECK           Check Latest Delivery Date                                  .
IF_EX_ISM_PRODUCT_MASTER       I VOLUME_CALCULATE              Calculate Volume                                            .
IF_EX_ISM_PRODUCT_MASTER       I WEIGHT_CALCULATE              Calculate Net Weight                                        .
IF_EX_ISM_PROTOCOL_ORDERGE     I ADD_FIELD_VALUES              Enter Data in Customer Fields in Order Generation Log       .
IF_EX_ISM_PURCHASENR           I ORDER_GENERATION_GET          Set Purchase Order Number During Order Generation           .
IF_EX_ISM_PURCHASENR           I TRANSFER_DELIVERY_GET         Purchase Order Number for Goods Transfer Op.in Sub.Delivery .
IF_EX_ISM_PURCHASENR           I TRANSFER_RETURN_GET           Purchase Order Number for Goods Transfer Op.in Return Deliv..
IF_EX_ISM_PURCHASENR           I UNSOLD_GET                    Set Purchase Order Number for Returns and Subs.Delivery     .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANITITY_COPY       I COPY                          Copy Quantity Plan to New Quantity Plan Record              .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I CACHE_DATA                    Cache Data for Access                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I DELIVERED_QUANTITY_GET_FOR_BSPQuantity Delivered for an Issue and its Sales Area          .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I DELIVERED_QUAN_CONTRACT_GET   Define Delivery Quantity for Specific Contract              .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I GET_REC_RETURNCOLLECTION      Select Records for Return Collection                        .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I IN_ROLE_RM_FOR_ISSUE_GET      Define Return Quantity for Retail Customer                  .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I IN_ROLE_WE_FOR_ISSUE_GET      Define Quantity Delivered to Ship-To Party                  .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I QUANTITY_FOR_LIGHT            Define Delivery Quantity Contract-Specifically for Light    .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I REFRESH_BUFFER                Initialize Buffer Tables                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I SOLD_QUANTITY_GET             Sold Quantity of an Issue for Specific Sales Areas          .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPAST         I UNSOLD_QUAN_CONTRACT_GET      Define Return Quantity for Specific Contract                .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPLAN         I CALCULATE_QUANTITY            Calculate Quantity Fields                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPLAN         I CHECK_SHPQUANTITY             Check Changed Quantity                                      .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPLAN         I EDIT_DEMAND_ONCHANGE          Change Quantity Fields According to User Entries            .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPLAN         I EDIT_DEMAND_ONSELECT          Check and Change Quantity Table While Reading from Database .
IF_EX_ISM_QUANTITYPLAN         I SET_SHPQUANTITY               Planned Delivery Quantity                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_RELEVANT_PMD_SET     I REDUCE_DATA_SETS              Restrict List of Media Product Master Records               .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_FORCAST     I OUTLIER_CORRECTION            Correct Reference Quantities                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_FORCAST     I SALESFORECAST_CALCULATE       Calculate New Sales Quantity (from Reference Issues)        .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_FORCAST     I SALESFORECAST_MODIFY          Postedit Forecast Calculated                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_REF         I OUTLIER_CORRECTION            Correct Reference Quantities                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_REF         I SALESFORECAST_CALCULATE       Calculate New Sales Quantity (from Reference Issues)        .
IF_EX_ISM_SALEQUAN_REF         I SALESFORECAST_MODIFY          Postedit Forecast Calculated                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SALESQUAN_FOREC      I OUTLIER_CORRECTION            Correct Reference Quantities                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SALESQUAN_FOREC      I SALESFORECAST_CALCULATE       Calculate New Sales Quantity (from Reference Issues)        .
IF_EX_ISM_SALESQUAN_FOREC      I SALESFORECAST_MODIFY          Postedit Forecast Calculated                                .
IF_EX_ISM_SCHEDULES            I CHANGE_SINGLE_COPY_SALE_IN    Change Schedule Line Data for Retail via Internet           .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I AFTER_UCOMM                   Further Actions After Processing                            .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE_DEM      Adjust BAPI Structures for Quantity Plan                    .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE_GP       Adjust BAPI Structures for Business Partner                 .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE_KON      Adjust BAPI Structures for Contract                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE_VKONT    Adjust Contract Acct Pyt Method and Contract Acct Cat.      .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_AG       Transport Data from Sold-To Party Screen                    .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_KON      Transport Data from Contract Screen                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_WE       Transport Data from Ship-To Party Screen                    .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I GET_NUMBERRANGE               Set Account Group and Number Range                          .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_AG         Transport Data to Sold-To Party Screen                      .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_KON        Transport Data from Contract Screen                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_WE         Transport Data to Ship-To Party Screen                      .
IF_EX_ISM_SDBPFAST             I SET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Assign Default Values                                       .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_ADDP_RECEIVER     I GET_CARRIER                   Determine Carrier                                           .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_ADDP_RECEIVER     I GET_FOUNDATION                Determine Social Facility                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CMPL_BILLED       I CHANGE_COMPLAINT_BILLED_FLAG  Select 'Complaint Billed' Indicator                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CMPL_SHIPDATE     I CHANGE_SHIP_DATE_CARRIER_INFO Change Shipping Date in Carrier Data                        .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CMPL_SHIPDATE     I PREALLOCATE_SHIP_DATE_INFO    Assign Default Shipping Date in Carrier Data                .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_COLLECT_REFUS     I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_INTERFACE   Research Data when Creating Research from DTAUS             .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_COMPL_DATA        I CHECK_DATA_OF_COMPLAINT       Check Complaint                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_COMPL_TJAPZ       I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_OF_TJAPZ    Change Parameters for TJAPZ                                 .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CONTRACT_ASRT     I CONTRACT_CHANGE_PARAMETERS    Parameters for BAPI 'Change Customer Contract'              .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CONTRACT_ASRT     I CONTRACT_CREATE_PARAMETERS    Parameters for BAPI 'Create Customer Contract'              .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CONTRACT_ASRT     I CONTRACT_ITEM_DETERMINE       Determine New Contract Item for an Article                  .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_CONTRACT_ASRT     I CONTRACT_ITEM_EXCLUSION       Check Relevancy of Listing Exclusion for Contract Item      .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_FULL_DIALOG       I CHANGE_BDCTAB                 Adjust BDC Table for Batch Input                            .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_ORDER_LIST        I CHANGE_ORDER_TAB              Change List of Orders To Be Displayed on Screen             .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_PRICE_ALTER       I ORDER_RELEVANCE_CHECK         Check Relevance of Order                                    .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_ORDERS_STP     I CREATE_UD_FOR_RELEVANT_ORDERS Create Further ND Notifications for Ship-To Party           .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_STATE          I SET_STATE                     Set Status of ND Notification                               .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I CANCELLATION_RELEVANCE        Check Relevancy - Create Termination?                       .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_CANCELLATIONChange Parameters for Creating Termination                  .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_COMPLAINT   Change Parameters for Creating Complaint                    .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_SUSPENSION  Change Parameters for Creating Suspension                   .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I CHANGE_PARAMETERS_SUSP_LIMIT  Change Parameter for Limiting a Suspension                  .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I SUSPENSION_COMPLAINT_RELEVANCECheck Relevancy of Creating Suspension and Complaint        .
IF_EX_ISM_SD_UD_WORKITEMS      I SUSPENSION_RELEVANCE          Check Relevancy of Creating Suspension                      .
IF_EX_ISM_SELLPRODUCTWWW       I GET_PRODUCTS_SINGLE_COPY_SALE Determine Products for Retail                               .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I DYNAMIC_PRESET_POS_SUM_UNSOLD Dynamic Preassignment for Item Recording of Summ. Returns   .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I DYNAMIC_PRESET_POS_UNSOLD     Dynamic Preassignment for Item Recording of Returns         .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I DYNAMIC_PRESET_WEEK_UNSOLD    Dynamic Preassignment for Weekly Returns Recording          .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I STATIC_PRESET_POS_SUM_UNSOLD  Static Preassignment for Item Recording of Summ. Returns    .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I STATIC_PRESET_POS_UNSOLD      Static Preassignment in Item Recording of Returns           .
IF_EX_ISM_SERVICECO_PRESET     I STATIC_PRESET_WEEK_UNSOLD     Static Preassignment for Weekly Returns Recording           .
IF_EX_ISM_SETTLEMENT_IF        I CHANGE_EXTERNAL_DELIVERY      Adjust Attributes of Delivery from External Interface       .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ACTIVATE_CONT     I SET_DISPLAY_DATE              Set Trial Period in Order                                   .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ACTIVATE_CONT     I SET_INSTALLATIONDATE          Set Installation Date in Contract                           .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_CONTRACTCREAT     I SPLIT_ORDER_ITEMS             Distribute Order Items Among Contract Items                 .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ORDER             I ORDER_GENERATED               Series Sales Order Created By Order Generation              .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ORDER             I SET_STARTORDER                Set Basic Edition Order in Order                            .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ORDERCREATION     I BUFFER_DATA_FOR_FRAMEWORK     Buffer Data for Evaluation in Framework                     .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ORDERCREATION     I CHANGE_DATA_BEFORE_RFC        Change Order Data Before RFC Process for Order Creation     .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_ORDERCREATION     I SET_FIELDS_R3                 Enter Data in Add. Fields if no Copying Control in ERP      .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_PRICESETCHECK     I ADDITIONAL_VALUES             Import Customer Fields                                      .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_PRICESETCHECK     I ADJUST_PRICEGROUP             Adjust Price Groups                                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SE_PRICESETCHECK     I CHECK_PRICEGROUP              Check Price Groups Before Saving                            .
IF_EX_ISM_SHIPORDPOS_DELIV     I SHIPORDPOS_DELIV_PARAMETER_GETExecute Before Del.Via.Determination for Shipping Order Item.
IF_EX_ISM_SHIPORD_REF_PVA      I SHIPORDPOS_REF_PVA_GET        Execute Before Del.Via.Determination for Shipping Order Item.
IF_EX_ISM_SHIPPING_PLAN        I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes for Shipping Schedule Record                 .
IF_EX_ISM_SHIPPING_PLAN        I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set Text for Shipping Schedule Record                       .
IF_EX_ISM_SHIPPING_PLAN        I STATUS_CHANGED                Status of Shipping Planning Changed                         .
IF_EX_ISM_SUPPLYNET            I PLANT_GET_INIT                Ermittlung des Werks vor normaler Werksermittlung           .
IF_EX_ISM_TMCP_SUB_MERGE       I TMCP_MERGE_SUB_SHIP_TO_PARTY  Total Market Coverage: Merge Ship-To Pties Against M/SD Subs.
IF_EX_ISM_TMC_FILTER           I APPLY_TABLE_FILTER            filter operation on table type ANY                          .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLD               I CHANGE_HEAD_DATA              Change Header Data on a Request                             .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLD               I GET_COLLECT_NUMBER            Define Collection Number for Return Index                   .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLD               I GET_ROLE_FOR_RETURNORDER      Define Additional Partner Role in Return Order              .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLD               I RETURNRELEASED                Return released                                             .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLDQUANTITY       I DISTRIBUTE                    Distribution of Return Quantity                             .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLDQUANTITY       I DISTRIBUTE_SUMMARIZED_RETURN  Distribute Summarized Return Between Issues                 .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLDQUANTITY       I SETCONFIRMED_QUANTITY         Set Confirmed Quantity Entered in Online Processing         .
IF_EX_ISM_UNSOLDQUANTITY       I SETCONFIRMED_QUANTITY_EXTERN  Set Confirmed Quantity Entered Externally                   .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Local Memory                                     .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I MAP_ADDITEM                   Transfer Fields in Additional Item in the Internal Display  .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I MAP_HEADER                    Transfer Fields in Document Header in the Internal Display  .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I MAP_ITEM                      Transfer Fields in Document Item in the Internal Display    .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I MAP_TAXITEM                   Transfer Fields in Tax Item in the Internal Display         .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I UPDATE                        Update                                                      .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BAPIBILL          I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Customer Update                                     .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I CHECK_INPUT_PARAMETERS        Check Input Parameter                                       .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I CHECK_REVERSAL_ORDER          Customer Reversal Sequence Check                            .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ADDITEM  Fill Customer Fields in Reversal Document Additional Items  .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_HEADER   Fill Customer Fields in Reversal Document Header            .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_ITEM     Fill Customer Fields in Reversal Document Items             .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I FILL_CUSTOMER_FIELDS_TAXITEM  Fill Customer Fields in Reversal Document Tax Items         .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I REVERSAL_ITEM_ANALYZE         Analyze Reversal Document Item                              .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I UPDATE                        Customer Update                                             .
IF_EX_ISTINV_BILL_CANCEL       I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Customer Update                                     .
IF_EX_ISU_AMIO_ARCHIVE         I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Anylyze Whether Parked Documents Can Be Archived            .
IF_EX_ISU_BADI_CONCELIG        I CONC_BP_VALIDATE              Validate Business Partner                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_BADI_CONCELIG        I CONC_TYPE_VALIDATE            Validate Concession Type                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_BADI_CONCTYPE        I CONC_TYPE_ALL                 Validate All Concession Type Entries                        .
IF_EX_ISU_BENDEF_EPVG          I DETERMINE_BENDEF_EPVG         Determination of User-Defined Cons. for Each Weighting Unit .
IF_EX_ISU_BENDEF_WEIGHTING     I DETERMINE_BENDEF_WEIGHT       Determination of User-Defined Weighting Sum                 .
IF_EX_ISU_BFPS_APIV            I CHECK_APIV                    Checks for Alternative Portion in Contract                  .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_BBP_EXT_PER       I CHANGE_PERIOD                 Adjust Extrapolation Period                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_BLOCK_BILLING     I BLOCK_BILLING_CHECK           Determine Relevance of Billing Block                        .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_EASIM             I CHANGE_ALV_FIELDCATALOG       Change Field Catalog for EASIMLINE                          .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_EASIM             I CHANGE_RESULT_EASIMLINE       Modify Results Table                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_CONSREL_BILLDOCS_DET  Determine Consumption-Relevant Billing Docs. from Sec. Inst..
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_CONSREL_ERCHV_GET     Determine Consumption-Relevant ERCHVs from Secondary Inst.  .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_DISTREL_BILLDOCS_DET  Determine Distribution-Relevant Billing Docs from Sec. Inst..
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_DISTREL_ERCHV_GET     Determine Distribution-Relevant ERCHVs from Secondary Inst. .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_ENDABRPE_CHECK        Check ENDABRPE from Secondary Installation                  .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_INSTGR            I SUBINST_SAVE_DISTDATA         Copy Distribution Data to Local Memory                      .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_KPI_PROCESS       I LOAD_CUSTOMER_DATA            Enhancement of KPI-Relevant Data                            .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_MASS_SIMUL        I BILL_EXTRAPOLATION            Document Extrapolation                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_MASS_SIMUL        I SIM_METHOD_DETERMINE          Define Method and Period of Simulation                      .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_MIBILL            I SELECT_MI_SCHEMA_STEPS        Determine Schema Step for Billing at Move-In                .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_PR_BLOCK_ADJ      I PRICE_BLOCK_ADJUST            Customer-Specific Price Block Adjustment                    .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_SELCONTROL        I GET_DATE_CHANGE_FACTS         Defines Access Date and Changes Internal Fact Tables        .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_SIM_PRICE         I CHANGE_IPREI                  Simulate IPREI                                              .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_TC_INTERVAL       I CUST_DET_OF_PERIOD            Customer-Specific Calculation of Period                     .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_USAGE_FACTOR      I USAGE_FACTOR_TIMESLICES       Time Slices for Usage Factor                                .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB               I BILL_OUTLINE_CONTRACT         Cross-Contract Billing                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_BONUS_COMPRESS_ERCHVAggregates the ERCHV Lines                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_BONUS_COMP_CHECK    Checks that all Individual Contracts Exist for Outline Contr.
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_BON_CUSTOMER_ACTION Execute Customer-Specific Actions                           .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_JOIN_COMPRESS_ERCHV Aggregates the ERCHV Lines                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_JOIN_COMP_CHECK     Checks that all Individual Contracts Exist for Outline Contr.
IF_EX_ISU_BI_XCB_ACTIONS       I OUTL_BILL_JOIN_CUSTOMER_ACTIONExecute Customer-Specific Actions                           .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_CHCONTRACTS       I REDUCECONTRACTS               Restrict Contracts                                          .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_KPI_CS            I ENHANCE_CL_CS01               Enhance Clarification for Move-In / Move-Out / Move-In/Out  .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_KPI_CS            I ENHANCE_CL_CS02               Enhance Clarification for Rate Maintenance                  .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_KPI_CS            I ENHANCE_NCL_CS01              Enhance Non-Clarif. for Move-In / Move-Out / Move-In/Out    .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_KPI_CS            I ENHANCE_NCL_CS02              Enhance Non-Clarification for Rate Maintenance              .
IF_EX_ISU_BW_SALES_SIM_01      I MODIFYEXTRACT                 Modify Extract                                              .
IF_EX_ISU_CIC_CCM_HTML_WS      I GET_HTML_WS_INTERFACE         Returns an Instance of Interface if_ccm_workspace           .
IF_EX_ISU_CIC_ENV              I ADD_CHILDREN                  Add Subordinate Nodes                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_CIC_EWHV             I GET_TEXT                      Read Long Text for Attribute                                .
IF_EX_ISU_CSBTIO_PRDOC         I CHECK                         Customer-Specific Checks                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_CSBTIO_PRDOC         I MDG_CONTAINER_MODIFY          Change Container for Master Data Generator                  .
IF_EX_ISU_CSBTIO_PRDOC         I OBJECT_DISTRIBUTE             Distribute Object Reference                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_CSBTIO_PRDOC         I OPEN_PREASSIGN                Customer-Specific Preassignments                            .
IF_EX_ISU_CSBTIO_PRDOC         I SCREEN_NUMBERS_REPLACE        Enter Customer-Specific Screen Numbers                      .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I CHECK_SEARCH_CRITERIA         Validity Check for Search Criteria                          .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I FILL_SEARCHPARAMETERS         Preparation of Search Criteria from Screen Data             .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Copy Data from Subscreen                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I GET_TAB_DESCRIPTION           Define Tab Description for Customer Enhancement Tab         .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I PARSE_SEARCHPARAMETERS        Preparation of Screen Data from Search Criteria             .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_FINDER_CSEL     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transfer Data to Subscreen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_CSFO_GENERSEARCH     I FILL_SEARCHPARAMTERS          Inserts Values from Free Text Field in the Search Parameter .
IF_EX_ISU_CSISS_E_SERVICE      I FIND_ACTUAL_CA                Determine Current Contract Account                          .
IF_EX_ISU_CUSTOMER_E_SERV      I FIND_ACTUAL_CA                Determine Current Contract Account                          .
IF_EX_ISU_DEF_BILL_PERIOD      I SET_BILLING_PERIOD_BILL       Determine Billing Period for Billing Document               .
IF_EX_ISU_DEF_BILL_PERIOD      I SET_BILLING_PERIOD_INV        Determine Billing Period for Print Document                 .
IF_EX_ISU_DM_SAPLIPW1          I EXIT_SAPLIPW1_008             Serial Number Check                                         .
IF_EX_ISU_EANL_ARCHIVE         I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze Whether Installations Can Be Archived               .
IF_EX_ISU_EDMIDE_SERVPROVH     I CHECK_INPUT_HISTDATA_CI       Checks on Historical Data in Customer Include               .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_BILL_CHECK       I CHECK_CHANGES_ALLOWED         Influence Billing Check                                     .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_EUFASSARCHIV     I ANALYSE_EUFASS                Analyze BOR Object for Achivability                         .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_FORMPROF         I CHANGE_STATUS_FLAGS           Change Status ID for Selection of Control Data              .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_POD_CUSTOMER     I CHANGE_AUTODATA               Data Transfer from AUTODATEN                                .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_POD_CUSTOMER     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_POD_CUSTOMER     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport for Screen                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_PROFHEAD         I CHECK_INPUT                   Input Check for Additional Data                             .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_PROFHEAD         I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_PROFHEAD         I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport for Screen                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_PROFLIST_TST     I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Entered Profile Values                                .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_SETTLUNIT        I CHECK_INPUT                   Input Check for Additional Data                             .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_SETTLUNIT        I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_SETTLUNIT        I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport for Screen                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_SETTL_ARCHIV     I ANALYSE_SETTLDOCS             Analyze Settlement Documents for Archivability              .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_TREE_TEXT        I ADDITIONAL_TEXTS              Read Additional Texts                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_UI_SETTLUNIT     I CHANGE_SYNCHRONISATION        Change Automatic Allocation                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_EDM_UI_SETTLUNIT     I SELECT_SETTLUNIT_SUPPLIER     Settlement Unit for PoD, Dependent on Suppliers             .
IF_EX_ISU_EGERR_CUSTOMER       I CHECK_DATA_FROM_SCREEN        Check User-Defined Fields                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_EGERR_CUSTOMER       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_EGERR_CUSTOMER       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport for Screen                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_EL_MONITORING        I EL31_CHECK_SELOPTIONS         Check Selection Criteria                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_EVBS_ARCHIVE         I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze Premise for Archivability                           .
IF_EX_ISU_EVERH_XREPLCNTL      I SET_XREPLCNTL                 Preselect Indicator                                         .
IF_EX_ISU_EVER_ARCHIVE         I ANALYSE_DOCUMENTS             Analyze Contracts for Archivability                         .
IF_EX_ISU_FACTS_ARCHIVE        I ANALYSE_FACTS                 Analyze Installation Facts for Archivability                .
IF_EX_ISU_GEWSCHL_EXTRAPOL     I DETERMINE_GWSCHL              Determination of Weighting Key for Extrapolation            .
IF_EX_ISU_IAC_MOVEOUT          I GET_SCREEN_DATA               User-defined check/transfer of fields                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IAC_MOVEOUT          I MODIFY_MOVEOUT_DATA           Changes to auto data for creating the move-out              .
IF_EX_ISU_IAC_MOVEOUT          I SET_SCREEN_DATA               User-defined data preassignment for screen fields           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_BUDBILPLANS        Authorization for Budget Billing Plan in CIC Tree           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_EDM_TREE           Authorization Checks for EDM Tree                           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_INSTLN             Authorization Checks for Installation                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_ISUACCOUNT         Authorization Checks for Contract Account                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_ISUCONTRACT        Authorization Checks for Contract                           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_ISUPARTNER         Authorization Checks for Business Partner                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_POD_TAB            Authorization Checks for Point of Delivery Tab Page         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_PRINTDOC           Authorization Checks for Print Documents                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_PROFILE            Authorization Checks for Profile and Profile Values         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CHECK_AUTH_SERVICES           Authorization Checks for Displaying Non-Billable Services   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDEX_AUTH_CHECK      I CLEAR_BUFFER                  Delete Buffer Tables                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_FORMAT      I FILL_EXTENSION_OUT            Fill Output Parameter for BAPI_ISUTASK_GETCOMMCONTROL       .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I INBOUND_DETERMINE_POD         Point of Delivery ID                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I INBOUND_DETERMINE_SERVPROV    Determine Service Provider                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I INBOUND_DETERMINE_SWTVIEW     Determine Switch View                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I INBOUND_UTILMD_IN_ANALYSE     Read Information from IDoc                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I OUTBOUND_FILL_ADD_FIELDS      Fill Additional Fields                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COMM_SWT         I OUTBOUND_UTILMD_OUT_BUILD     Fill IDoc                                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COM_CONTROL      I COND_DETERMINE_INBOUND        Standard COND TYPE & VALUE Determination (Inbound)          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COM_CONTROL      I COND_DETERMINE_OUTBOUND       Standard COND TYPE & VALUE Determination (Outbound)         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_COM_CONTROL      I OPAREA_DETERMINE              Standard OPAREA Determination via Distributor               .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_CROSS_REF_NO     I EXT_CROSSREF_PROVIDE          Determination of External Cross Reference Number            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_CROSS_REF_NO     I MISSING_CRN_VALIDATE_1        Check in Invoicing Whether CRN is Allowed to be Missing     .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_CROSS_REF_NO     I MISSING_CRN_VALIDATE_2        Check in Billing Rev. Whether CRN is Allowed to be Missing  .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_ACCOUNT_CHANGED  Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_account_changed          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_BILLINGINST_CHNG Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_billinginst_changed      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_COADDR_CHANGED   Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_coaddr_changed           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_CONTRACT_CHANGED Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_contract_changed         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_INSTFACTS_CHNG   Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_instfacts_changed        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_INSTLN_CHANGED   Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_instln_changed           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_LPASS_CHANGED    Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_lpass_changed            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_NBSERVICE_CHANGEDFramework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_nbservice_changed        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_PARTNER_CHANGED  Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_partner_changed          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_POD_CHANGED      Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_pod/uisettlu_changed     .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_PREMISE_CHANGED  Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_premise_changed          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_PROCESS_INVOICE  Framework: DATEX Call in isu_comev_process_invoice          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_SWITCH_OUT       Framework: DATEX Call in CL_ISU_IDE_SWITCH_COM="SEND_MSGDATA.
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DATEXCONNECT     I DATEXCONNECT_USAGE_INFO       Framework: DATEX Call in isu_prepare_usage_info             .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DELETETASK       I DELETE_CHECK                  Check Whether Data Exchange Tasks Can Be Deleted            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_ANA      I SELECT_SCENARIO               Select Utility Scenario That Applies to PoD                 .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I ASSIGN_CACCOUNT               Allocate Contract Accounts to New Contracts                 .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CANCEL_CONTRACT               Reverse Contract                                            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CANCEL_SERVICE                Reverse Service                                             .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CHANGE_INSTLN                 Change installation                                         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CONTINUE_CONTRACT             Reactivate Contract (Reverse Move-Out)                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CONTINUE_SERVICE              Reactivate Service                                          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CREATE_CACCOUNT               Create contract account                                     .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CREATE_CONTRACT               Create Contract                                             .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CREATE_INSTLN                 Create Installation                                         .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I CREATE_SERVICE                Create Service                                              .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I FILL_PARAMETER_CACCOUNT       Additional Parameters for Contract Account                  .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I FILL_PARAMETER_CONTRACT       Additional Parameters for Contract                          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I FILL_PARAMETER_INSTLN         Additional Parameters for Installation                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I FILL_PARAMETER_SERVICE        Additional Parameters for Service                           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I SHIFT_CONTRACT                Postpone Contract                                           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I SHIFT_SERVICE                 Postpone Service                                            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I STOP_CONTRACT                 End contract                                                .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_DRGSCEN_GEN      I STOP_SERVICE                  End Service                                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_ENROLL           I ENROLL_TYPE_DETERMINE         Standard ENROLL TYPE Determination                          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I BUILD_OUTBOUND                Distribute Outgoing Aggregated IDocs                        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I BUILD_OUTBOUND_PROTOCOL       Fill Log for Outgoing Aggregated IDocs                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I DETERMINE_AGGR_DEXIDOCSEND    Determine Aggregation-Relevant IDoc Sending Types           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I DETERMINE_SWITCH_DEXPROC      Determine Switch-Relevant Data Exchange Processes           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MERGE_IDOC_EXPPROFILE         Aggregation of MSCONS IDocs for Profiles                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MERGE_IDOC_EXPSWT             Aggregation of UTILMD IDocs for Change of Supplier          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MON_ADD_CUSTOMER_DATA         Monitoring: Insert Additional Entries                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MON_COUNT_MESSAGES            Monitoring: Determine Number of Messages per IDoc           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MON_EDIT_ALV_CHARACTERISTICS  Monitoring: Influence ALV Attributes                        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MON_EDIT_STATUS               Monitoring: Determine Status Grouping for Messages          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_IDOC_MERGE       I MON_FILL_CUSTOMER_DATA        Monitoring: Read Additional Data                            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_INV_TAX          I DETERMINE_TAX_DATA            Determination of Tax Date                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_NBSERVICE        I CHECK_CUSTOMER_DATA           Check of Customer Fields from CI_ESERVICE                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SCENARIO         I SCENARIO_DEFINE               Up To 4.64: Contains Scenario Definitions                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_ACT_COLUMNS               Activities: Set Characteristics for Columns                 .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_ACT_FILL                  Activities: Enter Data                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_ACT_HOTSPOT               Activities: Hotspot Navigation                              .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_ACT_LAYOUT                Activities: Set Layout                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_ACT_SORTING               Activities: Set Default Sorting                             .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_COLUMNS           Message Data: Set Characteristics for Columns               .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_COMPARE           Message Data: Comparison of Fields                          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_FILL              Message Data: Enter Data                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_HOTSPOT           Message Data: Hotspot Navigation                            .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_LAYOUT            Message Data: Set Layout                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I ALV_MSGDATA_SORTING           Message Data: Set Default Sorting                           .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I CI_HEAD_SUBSCREEN_FREE_CONTR  Customer Enhancement Header Data: Release Subscreen Controls.
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I CI_HEAD_SUBSCREEN_INIT        Customer Enhancement Header Data: Initialize Subscreen      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I CI_HEAD_SUBSCREEN_PBO         Customer Enhancement Header Data: Sunscreen PBO             .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I FIND_SWITCHDOC                Find Switch Document                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I INTERPRET_MSGDATA             Interpret Message Data                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_CREATION_CHECK        Is It Possible to Generate Message Data?                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_SUBSCREEN_FREE_CONTR  Message Data Dialog: Release Resources                      .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_SUBSCREEN_INIT        Message Data Dialog: Init                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_SUBSCREEN_INPUT       Message Data Dialog: Check and Transfer                     .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_SUBSCREEN_PAI         Message Data Dialog: PAI                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWITCHDOC        I MSGDATA_SUBSCREEN_PBO         Message Data Dialog: PBO                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_SWT_ARCHIVE      I ANALYSE_SWITCHDOC             Analyze Switch Documents for Archivability                  .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_TASK_HIERARC     I GENERATE_HIERARCHY            Generate Hierarchy                                          .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_TASK_HIERARC     I SELECT_HIERARCHY_DATA         Select Hierarchy Data                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IDE_UI_PODGROUP      I UPDATE_ASSIGNMENT             Update allocation                                           .
IF_EX_ISU_INTERVAL_CHECK       I INTERVAL_CHECK                Suppression Logic for Flat-Rate Installations               .
IF_EX_ISU_INT_SYST_INV         I CHANGE_INVOICE_DATA           Change or Add to Bill Receipt Data                          .
IF_EX_ISU_INT_SYST_REM         I CHANGE_REMADV_DATA            Change or Add to Data for Internal PAN Processing           .
IF_EX_ISU_INV_KPI_PROCESS      I LOAD_CUSTOMER_DATA            Enhancement of KPI-Relevant Data                            .
IF_EX_ISU_INV_REMADV_DLG       I CHECK_USER_INPUT              Check User Entries of Bill/PAN Dialog                       .
IF_EX_ISU_IN_KPI_PROCESS       I LOAD_CUSTOMER_DATA            Enhancement of KPI-Relevant Data                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MDG_CHECK_ATTRID     I ADJUST_ATTRID                 Evaluates a Master Data Generator Attribute in Customizing  .
IF_EX_ISU_MOVEIN_CUSTOMIZE     I GETCUSTOMIZING                Override Customizing                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_MOVEIN_MENUE         I MENU_BAR_ENTRIES_ADD          Add Menu Bar Entries                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_MOVEIN_SETBPADDR     I SETMOVEINBPADDR               Set Standard Address of Move-In Customer                    .
IF_EX_ISU_MOVEOUT_MENUE        I MENU_BAR_ENTRIES_ADD          Add Menu Bar Entries                                        .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_CSR_SORT          I PROVIDE_EABL                  Transfer Meter Reading Documents                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_DOWNLOAD_OSB      I CREATE_ONSITE_BILL_DATA       Generate Data for Onsite Billing                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_EABL_UPD          I ADD_EABL_TO_OBJECT_UPD        Add EABLs for Update to MR Object                           .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_FORMAL_CHECK      I MR_FORMAL_CHECK               User-Defined Formal Checks                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_INTERPOL_CHCK     I INTERPOL_CHECK                Customer-Specific Check for Interpolation Permissibility    .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_KPI_PROCESS       I ENHANCE_CL_MR                 Enhance Meter Reading: Clarification                        .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_KPI_PROCESS       I ENHANCE_NCL_MR                Enhance Meter Reading: Non-Clarification                    .
IF_EX_ISU_MR_PPM_CONTRREAD     I DETERMINE_PPM_CONTRREAD       Generation of Control Meter Readings for PPM Devices        .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I01_ORDER         I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for Service Orders with IS-U Data         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I01_ORDER         I GETLIST                       List with keys for Service Orders with IS-U Data            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I01_ORDER         I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for Service Orders with IS-U Data 3.0       .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I01_ORDER         I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Service Orders with IS-U Data 3.0          .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I02_NOTIF         I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for Service Notifications with IS-U Data  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I02_NOTIF         I GETLIST                       List with Keys for Service Notifications with IS-U Data     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I02_NOTIF         I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for Service Notifications with IS-U Data 3.0.
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I02_NOTIF         I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Service Notifications with IS-U Data 3.0   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I03_GET_CUST      I GET_VARIANT                   Get Variant                                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I03_METERREAD     I GETDETAIL                     List of Details for Meter Reading Orders with IS-U Data     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I03_METERREAD     I GETLIST                       List of Meter Reading Units                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I03_METERREAD     I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for Meter Reading Orders with IS-U Data 3.0 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I03_METERREAD     I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Meter Reading Units 3.0                             .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I10_MREP          I AFTER                         After Calling FUBA ISU_S_WORKLIST_INSTALL                   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I10_MREP          I BEFORE                        Before Calling FUBA ISU_S_WORKLIST_INSTALL                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I10_MREP          I MAU30_AFTER                   After Calling Function Module ISU_S_WORKLIST_INSTALL 3.0    .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I10_MREP          I MAU30_BEFORE                  Before Calling Function Module ISU_S_WORKLIST_INSTALL 3.0   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I11_PAY           I AFTER                         After Calling Function Module FKK_CREATE_DOC_AND_CLEAR      .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I11_PAY           I BEFORE                        Before Calling Function Module FKK_CREATE_DOC_AND_CLEAR     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I11_PAY           I MAU30_AFTER                   After Calling Function Module FKK_CREATE_DOC_AND_CLEAR 3.0  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I11_PAY           I MAU30_BEFORE                  Before Calling Function Module FKK_CREATE_DOC_AND_CLEAR 3.0 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I12_DISC          I AFTER                         After Calling Function Module ISU_S_DISCDOC_CHANGE          .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I12_DISC          I BEFORE                        Before Calling Function Module ISU_S_DISCDOC_CHANGE         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I12_DISC          I MAU30_AFTER                   After Calling Function Module ISU_S_DISCDOC_CHANGE 3.0      .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I12_DISC          I MAU30_BEFORE                  Before Calling Function Module ISU_S_DISCDOC_CHANGE 3.0     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I13_MREAD         I AFTER                         Exit After Calling BAPI_MTRREADDOC_UPLOAD                   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I13_MREAD         I BEFORE                        Exit Before Calling BAPI_MTRREADDOC_UPLOAD                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I13_MREAD         I MAU30_AFTER                   Exit After Calling BAPI_MTRREADDOC_UPLOAD 3.0               .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I13_MREAD         I MAU30_BEFORE                  Exit Before Calling BAPI_MTRREADDOC_UPLOAD 3.0              .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I14_MRNOTE        I AFTER                         Exit After Calling Function Module FUBA ISU_S_NOTE_CREATE_DI.
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I14_MRNOTE        I BEFORE                        Exit After Calling Function Module FUBA ISU_S_NOTE_CREATE_DI.
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I14_MRNOTE        I MAU30_AFTER                   Exit After Calling Function Module ISU_S_NOTE_CREATE_DI 3.0 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I14_MRNOTE        I MAU30_BEFORE                  Exit After Calling Function Module ISU_S_NOTE_CREATE_DI 3.0 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I20_NOTE          I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a Meter Reading Note                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I20_NOTE          I GETLIST                       List with Keys for a Meter Reading Note                     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I20_NOTE          I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Meter Reading Note, 3.0               .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I20_NOTE          I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Meter Reading Notes, 3.0                   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I21_CONF          I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a Disconnection / Reconnection Status .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I21_CONF          I GETLIST                       List with Keys for a Disconnection / Reconnection Status    .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I21_CONF          I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Disconnection/Reconnection Status, 3.0.
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I21_CONF          I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Disconnection/Reconnection Statuses, 3.0   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I22_MRTYPE        I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a User-Defined Meter Reading Category .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I22_MRTYPE        I GETLIST                       List with Keys for a User-Defined Meter Reading Category    .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I22_MRTYPE        I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for User-Defined Meter Reading Category, 3.0.
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I22_MRTYPE        I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for User-Defined Meter Reading Categories, 3.0 .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I23_DTYPE         I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a User-Defined Document Type          .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I23_DTYPE         I GETLIST                       List with Keys for a User-Defined Document Type             .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I23_DTYPE         I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a User-Defined Document Type, 3.0       .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I23_DTYPE         I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for User-Defined Document Types, 3.0           .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I24_ACT           I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for User-Defined Activity Reasons         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I24_ACT           I GETLIST                       List with Keys for User-Defined Activity Reasons            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I24_ACT           I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for User-Defined Activity Reasons, 3.0      .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I24_ACT           I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for User-Defined Activity Reasons, 3.0         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I25_CURR          I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a Currency                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I25_CURR          I GETLIST                       List with Keys for a Currency                               .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I25_CURR          I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Currency, 3.0                         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I25_CURR          I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Currencies, 3.0                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I26_DISCT         I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for Disconnection Types                   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I26_DISCT         I GETLIST                       List with Keys for Disconnection Types                      .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I26_DISCT         I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for Disconnection Types, 3.0                .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I26_DISCT         I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Disconnection Types, 3.0                   .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I27_MATNR         I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a Material                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I27_MATNR         I GETLIST                       List of Keys for Materials                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I27_MATNR         I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Material, 3.0                         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I27_MATNR         I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Materials, 3.0                             .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I28_CUST          I GETDETAIL                     List with Details for a Scenario                            .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I28_CUST          I GETLIST                       List of Keys for Scenarios                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I28_CUST          I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Scenario, 3.0                         .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I28_CUST          I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Scenarios, 3.0                             .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I29_ABLHINW       I MAU30_GETDETAIL               Liste mit Details zu einem Ablesehinweis vom Ableser 3.0    .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I29_ABLHINW       I MAU30_GETLIST                 Liste mit Schlüsseln zu Ablesehinweisen vom Ableser 3.0     .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I30_ALLCUST       I MAU30_GETDETAIL               List of Details for a Scenario 3.0                          .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I30_ALLCUST       I MAU30_GETDETAIL_LIST          List of all keys for Details                                .
IF_EX_ISU_MU_I30_ALLCUST       I MAU30_GETLIST                 List of Keys for Scenarios 3.0                              .
IF_EX_ISU_ONSITE_BILLING       I CREATE_ONSITE_BILL_DATA       Generate Data for Onsite Billing                            .
IF_EX_ISU_PPM_PAYMENTS         I CHOOSE_BLART                  Select Desired Document Types                               .
IF_EX_ISU_RELCORRLIST_ALV      I EXTENSION_EABL_ALV            Enhance EABL_ALV for RELCORRLIST                            .
IF_EX_ISU_RELCORRLIST_F4       I F4_HELP_EABL_ALV              F4 Help for Customer-Specific Fields in ALV List            .
IF_EX_ISU_SCENARIO_SWITCH      I NEW_CONTRACT_CHANGE           Up to 4.64: Change Contract Data for New Contract           .
IF_EX_ISU_SCENARIO_SWITCH      I NEW_INST_OBJ_CHANGE           Up to 4.64: Change Installation Data for Init. Data Creation.
IF_EX_ISU_TO_BILL_GDPDU        I CHECK_DOCUMENTS_EXTRACTED     Check if Documents Have Already Been Extracted              .
IF_EX_ISU_TO_BILL_GDPDU        I ISU_GDPDU_ARCHIVE_CHECK       Only Relevant for Germany                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_TO_EMMA_MSG          I SUPPRESS_MSG_FOR_DISPLAY      suppress messages at user display level                     .
IF_EX_ISU_TO_EMMA_MSG          I SUPPRESS_MSG_FOR_PREP         suppress messages during preperation of mass activity       .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_ABBP            I ABBP_ADJ_PERM                 Adjust Authorization Check for Budget Billing Plan          .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_ABBP            I ABBP_GET_CA_DESCR             Read Contract Account Description                           .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_ABBP            I ABBP_GET_CUST_LIMITS          Read Percentage Limits for Budget Billing Amount Adjustment .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_BCONTCREATE     I ABBP_SAVE_CREATE_BCONT        Create Contact After Saving in ABBP                         .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_BCONTCREATE     I MTR_CREATE_BCONT              Create Contact After Saving Meter Readings                  .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_BCONTCREATE     I MVE_IN_CREATE_BCONT           Create Contact After Saving Parked Document                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_BCONTCREATE     I MVE_IO_CREATE_BCONT           Create Contact After Saving Parked Document                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_BCONTCREATE     I MVE_OUT_CREATE_BCONT          Create Contact After Saving Parked Document                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_CUSTOM                 Filters the Custom Tab                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_EVER_DETAIL            Filters Data for Detail View of Selected Contract           .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_EVER_LIST              Supplies Contracts for Business Partner / Contract Account  .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_FILTER_DATA            Filters Data for Contract Filter                            .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_HISTORY                Filters Data for Consumption Overview                       .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_METER_READING          Filters Data for Meter Readings for Selected Contract       .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_METER_READING_DATES    Filters the Meter Reading Data                              .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I FILTER_TECHNICAL_DETAIL       Filters Technical Data for Selected Contract                .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I HIST_CREATE_CUSTOM_DATA       Consumption History: Provision of Scheme                    .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_CO              I HIST_CREATE_DATA              Consumption History: Provision of Data                      .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_ABBP_CALCULATE           Enhancements for BD_ABBP_CALCULATE                          .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_ABBP_PREP_ADJ            Enhancements for BD_ABBP_PREP_ADJ                           .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_ABBP_READ                Enhancements for BD_ABBP_READ                               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_ADDRESS_CHECK_EXTENSION  Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_ADDRESS_CHECK              .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_BUPA_ADDRESS_EXTENSION   Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_BUPA_ADDRESS               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_CHECK_BANK_EXTENSION     Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_CHECK_BANK                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_COUNTRY_EXTENSION        Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_COUNTRY                    .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_INTERNET_GET_BANKDATA    Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_GET_BANKDATA               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_IN     Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_IN                    .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_INOUT  Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_INOUT                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_IN_PRINEnhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_IN_PRINT              .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_OUT    Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_MOVE_OUT                   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_PREMISE_IDENEnhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_PREMISE_IDENT              .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_READ_PREMISEEnhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_READ_PREMISES              .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_STRUCTURES  Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_STRUCTURES                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_EXTENSION       I UCES_MVE_INTERNET_VKONTO      Enhancements for BD_MVE_INTERNET_VKONTO                     .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I ABBP_CALL_SF_FUBA             Call Generated Adobe Form for Function Module               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I ABBP_FILL_FUNC_NAME           Enter Variables for FP_FUNCTION_MODULE_NAME Function Module .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I ABBP_SEND_MSG                 Send E-Mail                                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MTR_BEFORE_SEND_MSG           Fill Transfer Parameters for Send Message                   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MTR_CALL_SF_FUBA              Call Function Module for Generated Smart Form               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MTR_FILL_FUNC_NAME            Fill Variable for Function module 'SSF_FUNCTION_MODULE_NAME'.
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IN_BEFORE_SEND_MSG        Fill Transfer Parameters for Send Message                   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IN_CALL_SF_FUBA           Call Function Module for Generated Smart Form               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IN_FILL_FUNC_NAME         Fill Variable for Function module 'SSF_FUNCTION_MODULE_NAME'.
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IO_BEFORE_SEND_MSG        Fill Transfer Parameters for Send Message                   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IO_CALL_SF_FUBA           Call Function Module for Generated Smart Form               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_IO_FILL_FUNC_NAME         Fill Variable for Function module 'SSF_FUNCTION_MODULE_NAME'.
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_OUT_BEFORE_SEND_MSG       Fill Transfer Parameters for Send Message                   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_OUT_CALL_SF_FUBA          Call Function Module for Generated Smart Form               .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_MAIL            I MVE_OUT_FILL_FUNC_NAME        Fill Variable for Function module 'SSF_FUNCTION_MODULE_NAME'.
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MTR_CHANGE_METERCHECK         BADI Definition for Function Module BD_MTR_INTERNET_CHECK   .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MTR_CHANGE_METERLIST          BADI Definition for Function Module BD_MTR_INTERNET_READ    .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MTR_CHANGE_METERSAVE          BADI Definition for Function Module BD_MTR_INTERNET_SAVE    .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MTR_GET_DEV_MODE_1            BAdI Definition: Remove ISU_REGISTER_TO_READ_EVBS m1        .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MTR_GET_DEV_MODE_2            BAdI Definition: Remove ISU_REGISTER_TO_READ_EVBS m2        .
IF_EX_ISU_UCES_METERREAD       I MVE_GET_DEV                   BAdI Definition: Remove ISU_DB_EANL_SELECT_VST_SP mve       .
IF_EX_ISU_UPDEASTE_EPC         I UPDEASTE_EPC                  Execution of Other Actions on or Using EASTE Entries        .
IF_EX_ISU_VDEW_INVOIC_IN       I CHANGE_INVOICE_DATA           Change or Add to Bill Processing Data                       .
IF_EX_ISU_VDEW_INVOIC_OUT      I CHANGE_INVOICE_DATA           Change or Add to Bill Issue Data                            .
IF_EX_ISU_VDEW_INVOIC_OUT      I DETERMINE_DOCUMENT_DATE       Determination of Bill Period                                .
IF_EX_ISU_VDEW_INVOIC_OUT      I DETERMINE_QUANTITY            Determination of Quantities for Flat-Rates and Rental Prices.
IF_EX_ISU_VDEW_INVOIC_OUT      I DETERMINE_TAX_LINE_TYPE       Determination of Line Types for Duty and Other Taxes        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ADAPT_SERVICE     I ADAPT_SERVICES                Modifies Dependent Services for a Route                     .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_BILLING           I CHECK_AUTOMATIC_BILL_REV      Check Whether Automatic Adjustment Reversal is Possible     .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_BILLING           I CHECK_INTERIM_INSTALLATION    Check Previous Container Delivery in Installation Facts     .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_BILLING           I COMPRESS_TIMESLICES           Collapse (Artificially) Delimited Service Time Slices       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_BILLING           I DO_AUTOMATIC_BILL_REVERSAL    Execute Automatic Adjustment Reversal                       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_BILLING_EXEC      I ADOPT_AAT                     Adjust Billing-Relevant Waste Billing Categories            .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_CONT_INSTALL      I CHECK_CONTAINER_ALLOCATED     Check Whether Container Is Allocated to Container Location  .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_CONT_INSTALL      I INSTALL_CONTAINER             Install/Remove/Replace Container                            .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_CONT_INSTALL      I READ_SERVLOC_DATA             Read Container Location Data / Container Data               .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_CONT_INSTALL      I REVERSE_CONTAINER             Reverse Installation/Removal/Replacement of Container       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ELOC              I BALANCE_DIFFCULT              Comparison of Notes in Container Location with Service      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ELOC              I CHECK_CONTAINER_IS_FREE       Determine Next Free Container or Check Availability         .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ELOC              I CHECK_EO_ADDRESS              Address Check Between Premise and Container                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ELOC              I CHECK_EO_ALLOCATION           Check Whether Object Allocation is Permitted                .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_GOODSMOVEMENT     I SPLITWASTEAMOUNT              Splits Waste Quantity According to Guartr. Cont. Guidelines .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_GUARCONTRACT      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_HEAD     Transports Data Back from Header Data Subscreen             .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_GUARCONTRACT      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_HIST     Transports Data Back from Item Data Subscreen               .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_GUARCONTRACT      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_HEAD       Transports Data to Header Data Subscreen                    .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_GUARCONTRACT      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_HIST       Transports Data to Item Data Subscreen                      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_ALV_FIELDCAT           Define ALF List for Waste Disposal Order/Weighing Record    .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_FIELD_DISPLAY          Forward navigation                                          .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_ORDERPRINT             Print Waste Disposal Documents                              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_PINTPARAMS             Define Print Parameters for Waste Disposal Documents        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_CARGO             Update General Cargo Entry                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_SR                Update Service Frequency                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_WAORDER           Update Waste Disposal Order                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_WDPLANT           Update Waste Disposal Facility                              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_WEIGHNOTE         Update Waste Disposal Order                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I ACTION_SAVE_WEIGHPRC          Update Weighing Procedure                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I CHECKDATA_WAORDER             Check Data for Waste Disposal Order Item                    .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I CHECKDATA_WEIGHNOTE           Check Data for Weighing Data Records                        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_CARGO            Preparation for Update to General Cargo Entry               .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_SR               Preparation for Update to Service Frequency                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_WAORDER          Preparation for Update to Waste Disposal Order              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_WDPLANT          Preparation for Update to Waste Disposal Facility           .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_WEIGHNOTE        Preparation for Update to Waste Disposal Order              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PREPARE_SAVE_WEIGHPRC         Preparation for Update to Weighing Procedure                .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPAI_CARGO                 PAI General Cargo Entry                                     .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPAI_SR                    PAI Service Frequency                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPAI_WDPLANT               PAI Waste Disposal Facility                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPAI_WEIGHFAST             PAI Accelerated Weighing Entry                              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPAI_WEIGHPRC              PAI Weighing Procedure                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPBO_CARGO                 PBO General Cargo Entry                                     .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPBO_SR                    PBO Service Frequency                                       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPBO_WDPLANT               PBO Waste Disposal Facility                                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPBO_WEIGHFAST             PBO Accelerated Weighing Entry                              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_HAZARD_WASTE      I PROGPBO_WEIGHPRC              PBO Weighing Procedure                                      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CONFIRM     I PREPARE_CO_REPOSTING          Prepares CO Posting                                         .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CONFIRM     I UPDATE_DEBITREQUEST           Create/Revise SD Subsequent Document from Confirmation      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CONFIRM     I UPDATE_DEBITREQUEST_AFTER     After SD Subsequent Document Has Been Created/Changed       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CREATE      I CHECK_ORDERHD_EXISTING        Check Whether an Order Header Already Exists                .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CREATE      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Enters Values for Customer Fields                           .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CREATE      I PREPARE_ORDER_CREATE          Prepares the Creation of Waste Disposal Orders              .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_CREATE      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Enters Values in Customer Fields                            .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_DISPO       I FILTER_SELECTED_ROUTE         Route Restriction                                           .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_DISPO       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Customer Fields for Route Restriction                       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_DISPO       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Customer Fields for Route Restriction                       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_SELECT      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Enters Values for Customer Fields                           .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_SELECT      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Enters Values in Customer Fields                            .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ORDER_SELECT      I SELECT_ORDERS                 Selects Waste Disposal Orders                               .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_PROP              I DETERMINE_RATED_VALUE         Calculate Evaluated Measured Amounts                        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_PROP              I OPEN_PROP                     When Reading Data in OPEN Module                            .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_PROP              I SAVE_PROP                     When Saving Property Data                                   .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ROB_ADR_CHECK     I CHECK_ADDRESS                 Checks Address of Cleaning Object                           .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ROUTE_CHECK       I CHECK_ROUTE                   Checks Permissibility of Route in Service Frequency         .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_ROUTE_CHECK       I CHECK_ROUTE_ORDER_CREATE      Checks Permissibility of Interval for Route                 .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I ADAPT_SERVICE_DATE            Adjustment of Service to Agree With Contract Duration       .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I CHECK_BILLING_DATE            Check Change in Billed Period                               .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport Data from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I MODIFY_SGROUP_INPUT           Ready-For-Input Status of Fields from Service Grouping      .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I OPEN_SERVFREQ                 Call When Opening Service Frequency                         .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data to Screen                                    .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I SAVE_SERVFREQ                 Call Before Saving Service Frequency                        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SERVICE_FREQ      I SERVICE_GROUPING              Interpret Service Grouping                                  .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SF_CMPL_CHECK     I CHECK_COMPL_BEFORE_SAVE       Incompleteness Check Before Saving Service Frequency        .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SF_CMPL_CHECK     I CHECK_HEADER_FIELDS           Field Checks at Header Level                                .
IF_EX_ISU_WA_SF_CMPL_CHECK     I CHECK_SERVICE_FIELDS          Field Checks at Service Level                               .
IF_EX_ISU_WM_ADD_PARTNER       I ADD_PARTNER                   Create Partner Data for PM/SM Orders                        .
IF_EX_ISU_ZWIABRECH_EINZUG     I CREATE_INTERIMBILL            Generate Interim Meter Reading with Billing                 .
IF_EX_ISU_ZWIABRECH_WECHSL     I CREATE_INTERIMBILL_REPL       Generate Interim Meter Reading with Billing                 .
IF_EX_IVIEW_PROMO_DETAIL       I CHANGE                        Change Data and/or Layout of Promotion Detail Table         .
IF_EX_IVIEW_PROMO_OVERVIEW     I CHANGE                        Change Data and/or Layout of Promotion Table                .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I AUDISP_FOR_REFURB_ORDER       Define MRP-Relevance for Refurbishment Orders               .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I AUTHORITY_CHECK_AUART_ACTIVIT Authorization Check for PM/CS Order                         .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I CHANGE_COSTRELEVNCY           Change of Costing Relevance of Components                   .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I CONFIRMATIONDATE_CHANGEABLE   Confirmation Data for Maintenance Plan                      .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I CONTRACT_PRICE_GET            Determine whether the price is copied from the contract     .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I CREATE_BANF_FOR_IND_STOCK     Create PReq for Reservation for Sales Order Stock           .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I INVEST_ORDER_XRAIST01_ALTER   Modify Order-AuC Interface                                  .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I NO_CONTRACT_DATA_GET          Determine If Contract Data Should Be Copied                 .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I NO_RES_FOR_IND_STOCK          No Reservation for Sales Order Stock                        .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I ORDER_SCHEDULE                Determine whether the order should be scheduled             .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I REFERENCE_ORDER_CHK           Authorization Check on Initial Screen for Reference Order   .
IF_EX_IWO1_ORDER_BADI          I RKPF_MODIFY                   Change Reservation Header                                   .
IF_EX_IWO1_PREQ_BADI           I DECISION_COLL_PREQ            Decide on Collective Purch. Req. Item or New Purch. Req.    .
IF_EX_IWO1_PREQ_BADI           I DETERMINE_DATE_FOR_SERVICE    Determination of Date for Pricing                           .
IF_EX_IWO1_SCREEN_MODIFY       I CHANGE_SCREEN                 Set hidden indicator                                        .
IF_EX_IWO1_SUBSCREEN_0170      I GET_DATA                      Retrieve Data from Global Attributes                        .
IF_EX_IWO1_SUBSCREEN_0170      I PUT_DATA                      Transfer Data to Global Attributes                          .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION      I CHANGE_TL_COMP_DATA_1         Copying of Task List Components (PLMZ, STPOX)               .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION      I CHANGE_TL_COMP_DATA_2         Copying of Task List Components (RESBB)                     .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION      I CHANGE_TL_DATA                Copying of Task List Data                                   .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION      I CREATE_DUMMY_OPERATION        Creation of a Dummy Operation                               .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION2     I CHANGE_TL_COMP_DATA_1         Copying of Task List Components (PLMZ, STPOX)               .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION2     I CHANGE_TL_COMP_DATA_2         Copying of Task List Components (RESBB)                     .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION2     I CHANGE_TL_DATA                Copying of Task List Data                                   .
IF_EX_IWO1_TL_INTEGRATION2     I CREATE_DUMMY_OPERATION        Creation of a Dummy Operation                               .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I CHANGE_WKCTR_IN_NOTIF         In Message, Determine Work Center for Forwarding            .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I CHANGE_WKCTR_IN_ORDER         In Order, Determine Work Center for Forwarding              .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I CHK_MNWKCTR_IN_NOTIF          Check Work Center for Forwarding in Message                 .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I CHK_MNWKCTR_IN_ORDER          Check Work Center for Forwarding in Order                   .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I SET_INACTIVE_IN_NOTIF         Deactivate Switch in Message Using Parameters               .
IF_EX_IWO1_WKCTR_CHANGE        I SET_INACTIVE_IN_ORDER         Deactivate Switch in Order Using Parameters                 .
IF_EX_IWOC_LIST_TUNING         I CHANGE_VIEW                   Change Selection View                                       .
IF_EX_IWOC_OBJECTINFO_CHNG     I GET_PMIS_DATA                 Determine Key Figures on the Object Info Screen             .
IF_EX_IWO_MASS_CHANGE          I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authority Check                                             .
IF_EX_IWO_UI_USEFLEX           I EXEC_NEW                      Execute New UI                                              .
IF_EX_IWP3_INSP_PLAN_CHECK     I INSP_PLAN_CHECK_STABI         Check of Selected Inspection Plan                           .
IF_EX_IWP3_INSP_PLAN_CHECK     I PHYNR_CHECK_STABI             Check of Physical Sample in Schedule                        .
IF_EX_IWP3_INSP_TYPE_CHECK     I INSP_TYPE_CHECK               Check the Inspection Type for Inspection Lot Origin         .
IF_EX_IWP3_ROUTING_SELECT      I ROUTING_SELECTION             Inspection Plan Selection Using Lists                       .
IF_EX_JBA_SFGDT                I MODIFY_TRANSACTIONDATA        Changing a list of internal generic transactions (SFGDT)    .
IF_EX_JBA_US_PREPAYMENT        I ANALYSIS                      Method used to analyze and request Market Data              .
IF_EX_JBA_US_PREPAYMENT        I VALUATION                     Method used to modify cash flows with prepayment amounts    .
IF_EX_JBD_BP_EXP_AFTER_SEL     I MODIFYBPDATA                  Change Business Partner Data                                .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_COLL_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_FO_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_CP_FO_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_FO_GET_MULT       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_LIST          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_CP_GET_MULT          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_DETR_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FCTY_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_FO_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_LIST         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_LIST         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_LIST         I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FRA_GET_MULT         I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_FO_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_LIST         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_LIST         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_LIST         I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FTD_GET_MULT         I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_FO_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FX_FO_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_FO_GET_MULT       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_LIST          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_FX_GET_MULT          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_GETR_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LMB_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LMB_GET_MULT         I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LMB_GET_MULT         I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_LIST          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_LIST          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_MULT          I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LM_GET_MULT          I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_CF_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_CF_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_CF_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_LOAN_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDFX_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIR_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDIX_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDSE_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOFX_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIR_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOIX_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_MDVOSE_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_DE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_DE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_DE_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FO_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FO_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FX_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_FX_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_MD_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_MD_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_MD_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_SE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_SE_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_SE_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_S_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_S_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_S_GET_LIST       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_LIST      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_LIST      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_MULT      I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_VC_GET_MULT      I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_LIST       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_LIST       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_MULT       I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_POS_V_GET_MULT       I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_REL_EXP_AFTER_SE     I MODIFYRELDATA                 Change Data for Business Partner Relationships              .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SETR_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_LIST        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_LIST        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_MULT        I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_SWAP_GET_MULT        I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_LIST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_LIST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_LIST     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FD_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FO_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_FO_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_LIST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_LIST     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_LIST     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           Transfer of Extension Parameters to Internal Structures/Tble.
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_MULT     I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          Transer of Internal Structures/Tables to Output Parameters  .
IF_EX_JBD_VATR_MD_GET_MULT     I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           Verification of Input Parameters                            .
IF_EX_JBP_BADI_AFIXP           I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_JBP_BADI_AFLEXP          I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_JBP_BADI_BFIXP           I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_JBP_BADI_BFLEXP          I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_JBP_DIST_DERIVE_DIS1     I MODIFY_LINE_ITEM              Modify Line Items (Target Segment)                          .
IF_EX_JBP_FTP_CALCULATR_PA     I CHANGE_FTP_PARAMETERS         Change Tranche Parameters of Opportunity                    .
IF_EX_JBP_FTP_CALCULATR_PA     I DONT_LOG_INTERMEDIATE_RATES   Specify If Interest Rates Record Before Averaging Process   .
IF_EX_JITOUT_NUMBER_GET        I NUMBER_GET_NEXT               Assign Own Numbers for JIT Outbound Items                   .
IF_EX_JITO_ACTION              I AFTER_ACTION                  After the Action                                            .
IF_EX_JITO_ACTION              I BEFORE_ACTION                 Before the Action                                           .
IF_EX_JITO_ACTION              I CUSTOMER_ACTION               Customer Action                                             .
IF_EX_JITO_ACTION              I ERROR_CASE                    Error                                                       .
IF_EX_JITO_CREATE              I CHANGE_CALL_DATA              Change Release Data                                         .
IF_EX_JITO_DELCON              I CHECK_DELCON_CLOSING          Check Delivery Confirmation Closing                         .
IF_EX_JITO_IDOC                I CHANGE_IDOC_DELIVERY_CONFIRM  Delivery Confirmation IDoc Adjustment                       .
IF_EX_JITO_IDOC                I CHANGE_IDOC_JITCALL           JIT Call IDoc Adjustment                                    .
IF_EX_JITO_LAYOUT              I CHANGE_LAYOUT                 Change Field Catalog of Monitor (JITOM)                     .
IF_EX_JITO_LAYOUT              I FILL_ADDITIONAL_DATA          Filling the Additional Fields                               .
IF_EX_JITO_LAYOUT              I HANDLE_FCODE                  Function Code Handling                                      .
IF_EX_JITO_LAYOUT              I HANDLE_GOTO                   Link Handling                                               .
IF_EX_JITO_LAYOUT              I READ_ADDITIONAL_DATA          Reading Additional Data (Reference Data)                    .
IF_EX_JIT_DELCON               I ACTION                        Customer-specific Action After Posting IDoc DELCON          .
IF_EX_JIT_DELCON               I INVOICE_CREATION              Change the Data for Billing Document Creation               .
IF_EX_JIT_DELCON               I MAPPING                       Mapping for IDoc Processing of the IDoc DELCON              .
IF_EX_JIT_FIND_SA              I FIND_SCHEDULE_AGREEMENT       Determine Scheduling Agreement                              .
IF_EX_JIT_GM_TYPE              I GOODS_MOVEMENT_TYPE           Define Movement Type for Stock Transfer                     .
IF_EX_JIT_MONITOR              I HANDLE_FCODE                  FCODE Handling                                              .
IF_EX_JIT_NUMBER               I NUMBER_FOR_CG_TYPE            Assign Number of the Components Group Type Internally       .
IF_EX_JIT_NUMBER               I NUMBER_FOR_DESTINATION        Assign Number of the Destination Internally                 .
IF_EX_JOB_NAME_SELF            I JOB_NAME                      Job Name Add-In                                             .
IF_EX_J_1BWHT_BR_EXT           I DETERMINE_TAX_CODE            Determine Tax Code Used in WHT Calculation in Down Payments .
IF_EX_J_1B_EXBASE_GET          I GET_PRICE                     Determine price from customer specific source               .
IF_EX_J_1B_RANGE_NUMBER        I PRINT_CONFIGURATION           Change Nota Fiscal Print Configuration                      .
IF_EX_J_3RF_CH_ADDR            I SHIP_TO_PARTY_ADDR            Get New Address                                             .
IF_EX_KAOV_ORD_PLD_REVENUE     I PLANNED_REVENUE_UPDATE        Define Planned Revenue Update                               .
IF_EX_KAZB_OBJ_CHECK           I CHECK_AUTYP                   Check Order Category and Possible Deletion from Int. Table  .
IF_EX_KAZB_OBJ_CHECK           I CHECK_AUTYP_COWL              Check Order Type, Possible Deletion from ITAB, Worklist PCC .
IF_EX_KB6X_CUST_CHECK          I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_EX_KKAG0001                 I ABGRENZUNGSDATEN_AENDERN      Corresponds to Customer Enhancement 1 (EXIT_SAPLKKAG_001)   .
IF_EX_KKAG0001                 I BEWERTUNGSBASIS_AENDERN       Like EXIT_SAPLKKAG_002 But Only Valuation Basis             .
IF_EX_KKAG0008                 I EXTENDED_MESSAGE_HANDLING     Extended Subsequent Processing of Error Messages            .
IF_EX_KK_F_CHECK_OBJ_STAT      I OBJECT_SELECTION              Extension of Object Selection for Product Cost Collector    .
IF_EX_KK_F_QM_ORD_CREATE       I AT_SAVE_QM_ORDER              Exit Create QM Order                                        .
IF_EX_KMC_ATTACHMENT_AUTH      I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_EX_KPEP_WL_OBJECT           I GET_ROLE_ACTOR                Get Responsible for Object                                  .
IF_EX_KPEP_WL_OBJECT           I PREPARE_OUTPUT                Fill Fields Object_ext and Shorttext                        .
IF_EX_K_CCA_CUSTOMER_FIELD     I COSTCENTER_CREATE             Fill Customer Fields When Creating Cost Center              .
IF_EX_K_FM_CHECK_FOR_ALOC      I CHECK_SENDER_RECEIVER         Checks Sender and Receiver for Assessment                   .
IF_EX_K_FM_CHECK_FOR_ALOC      I CHECK_SENDER_RECEIVER_2       Checks Sender and Receiver for Allocation                   .
IF_EX_K_FM_CHECK_FOR_ALOC      I DERIVE_CHECK_CCSS             Derive and Check FM Account Assignment from CCSS            .
IF_EX_K_FM_CHECK_FOR_ALOC      I DERIVE_CHECK_COBL             Derive and Check FM Account Assignment from COBL            .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_RULE              I ENABLE_MAINTENANCE            Enable Definition of Plan Settlement Rule                   .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_RULE              I GET_RECEIVER                  Read Plan Settlement Receiver                               .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_SETTLEMENT        I CHECK_OBJECT                  Check Account Assignment Object                             .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_SETTLEMENT        I CHECK_RULE                    Check Distribution Rule                                     .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_SETTLEMENT        I CHECK_VERSION                 Check Plan Settlement                                       .
IF_EX_K_PLAN_SETTLEMENT        I CREATE_RULE                   Create Plan Settlement Rule                                 .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_1           I RW_CHANGE                     Change Selected Fields in FI/CO Document in the Settlement  .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I BTA_EXECUTE                   BTA Callup (EXECUTE)                                        .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I BTA_POST                      BTA Callup (POST)                                           .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I BTA_PREPARE                   BTA Callup (PREPARE)                                        .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I INITIALIZE                    Clear                                                       .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I STORE_CO_DATA                 Save Settlement Data: CO Receiver                           .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_2           I STORE_MA_DATA                 Save Settlement Data: Material Receiver                     .
IF_EX_K_SETTLEMENT_3           I MODIFY_SRULE                  Change Settlement Rule                                      .
IF_EX_LEDSP_SPLIT_EXECUTE      I EXECUTE                       Perform Subsequent Delivery Split                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I CHECK_AT_DELETION             Deletion of shipment document allowed?                      .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I CHECK_AT_SAVE                 Checks for Saving                                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I CHECK_EXT_ACTIV               Check whether extension is active                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I CHECK_TRTYP                   Change check of VT02n to VT03n                              .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I DRAG_NODES                    Warning screen when deliveries are moved                    .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I DROP_NODES                    Update ALV tree when delivieres are moved                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I NAVIGATE                      Screen Navigation                                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I NODES_REFRESH                 Update ALV Tree in Planning Screen                          .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I TABSTRIP_CONTROL              Goto Additional Tab Pages                                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I TOOLBAR_ACTIONS               Execute Toolbar Functions                                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I TOOLBAR_BUTTONS               Show/hide buttons                                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I VSO_PREPARE                   Prepare/start VSO                                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHPMNT_EXTENSION      I VSO_UPDATE                    Remove VSO Results                                          .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I CHANGE_DELIVERY_HEADER        Change of Own Data When Changing Header Data                .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I CHANGE_DELIVERY_ITEM          Change of Own Data When Changing an Item                    .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I CHANGE_FCODE_ATTRIBUTES       Control Activation of Function Codes                        .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I CHANGE_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES       Control Input Attributes of Delivery Fields                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I CHECK_ITEM_DELETION           Check Deletion of a Delivery Item                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I DELIVERY_DELETION             Delete Own Data when Deleting the Delivery                  .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I DELIVERY_FINAL_CHECK          Last Checks Before Saving the Delivery                      .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I DOCUMENT_NUMBER_PUBLISH       Publish Delivery Number After Number Assignment             .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I FILL_DELIVERY_HEADER          Determine Own Data when Creating the Delivery Header        .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I FILL_DELIVERY_ITEM            Determine Own Data when Creating an Item                    .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I INITIALIZE_DELIVERY           Initialize Own Data                                         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I ITEM_DELETION                 Delete Own Item-Dependent Data                              .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I PUBLISH_DELIVERY_ITEM         Publish Item Data After Processing                          .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I READ_DELIVERY                 Read Own Data After Delivery Has Been Read                  .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I SAVE_AND_PUBLISH_BEFORE_OUTPUTSave Own Data Before Message Output                         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I SAVE_AND_PUBLISH_DOCUMENT     Save Own Data/Publish Delivery                              .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DELIVERY_PROC     I SAVE_DOCUMENT_PREPARE         Last Determination Before Saving                            .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_DLV_GETLIST       I MODIFY_DELIVERIES             Modification to Deliveries                                  .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_EVAL_RESULT       I IDOC_EVALUATE_RESULT          Shipping notification (Inbound): Evaluate result (internal) .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_GN_DLV_CREATE     I MOVE_KOMDLGN_TO_LIKP          Transfer Fields from XKOMDLGN to XLIKP                      .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_GN_DLV_CREATE     I MOVE_KOMDLGN_TO_LIPS          Transfer Fields from XKOMDLGN to XLIPS                      .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_GOODSMOVEMENT     I CHANGE_INPUT_HEADER_AND_ITEMS Changes in Header (IMKPF) and Items (XIMSEG)                .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_ITEM_STATUS       I CHANGE_ITEM_STATUS            Change Item Status of Delivery Items                        .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_PRICING           I CHANGE_INPUT_HEADER_AND_ITEMS Changes in Header Struct. (TKOMK) and Item Structure (TKOMP).
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_AUID_HEAD     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_AUID_HEAD     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_AUID_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_AUID_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_HEAD     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_HEAD     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_ITEM     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_ITEM     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_ITEM     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_ITEM     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_OVER     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_OVER     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_OVER     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_CUST_OVER     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_HEAD     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_HEAD     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_ITEM     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_ITEM     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_ITEM     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_GLTR_ITEM     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_SCEM_HEAD     I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_SCEM_HEAD     I PASS_FCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN       Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_SCEM_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Data from Subscreen Back to Delivery         .
IF_EX_LE_SHP_TAB_SCEM_HEAD     I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_LE_WM_INV_WM_IM          I ADD_DATA                      Add to data before IM posting                               .
IF_EX_LE_WM_LATER_DN           I LATER_DN_CHANGE               Set Relevance for Late Delivery Update                      .
IF_EX_LE_WM_LATER_DN           I LATER_DN_PASSD                Update Delivery Immediately                                 .
IF_EX_LE_WM_LE_QUANT           I QUANT_POSTING_CHANGE          Quant Determination During Stock Transfer                   .
IF_EX_LE_WM_RF_QUEUE           I QUEUE_DETERMINATION           RF Queue Determination                                      .
IF_EX_LE_WM_STORAGETYPE_HU     I STORAGETYPE_DETERMINE         Determination of Storage Type for Handling Units            .
IF_EX_LE_WM_SUTYPE_HU          I SU_TYPE_DETERMINATION         Determination of Storage Unit Type for Handling Units       .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_ALL_ENTRIES_IN_4  Used for select  with all entries                           .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_ALL_FIELDS_FOR    Used for standard select and specified keys                 .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_ALL_FIELDS_IN     Used for select with all star and in range                  .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_LIFNR_ENTRIES     Used for select with all entries and in range with. LIFNR   .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_LIFNR_ENTRIES_IN_RUsed for select with all entries and in range               .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_LIFNR_ENTRIES_SPECUsed for select with special fields and all entries         .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_SPECIAL_FIELDS_FORUsed for select with special fields and specified keys      .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I SELECT_LFM2_SPECIAL_FIELDS_IN Used for select with special fields with ranges             .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_LFM2_FROM              Updates lfm2  from an internal table                        .
IF_EX_LFM2_DB_STRG             I UPDATE_LFM2_WHERE             Updates lfm2  when a condition is met                       .
IF_EX_LGE_ACTION_ACL           I ACTION                        Log entry action follow-up action                           .
IF_EX_LGE_ACTION_ACL           I CHECK                         Check log entry action                                      .
IF_EX_LGE_SUBSCR_ACL           I DUMMY                         No implementation necessary: is needed for technical reasons.
IF_EX_LGN_SUBSCR_ACL           I HIDE_TAB                      Hides SAP standard tab strip in log notification            .
IF_EX_LGN_SUBSCR_ACL           I PROCESS_FUNCTION              Process by customer activated function in the log notif.    .
IF_EX_LISTING_BADI             I TRANSFER_WLK1                 Transfer of WLK1 Data                                       .
IF_EX_LISTING_BADI             I TRANSFER_WRS1                 Transfer of WRS1 Data                                       .
IF_EX_LISTING_BADI             I TRANSFER_WRS6                 Transfer of WRS6 Data                                       .
IF_EX_LISTING_BADI             I TRANSFER_WRSZ                 Transfer of WRSZ Data                                       .
IF_EX_LISTING_DIFF             I CHANGE_DATAB                  Changing of DATAB on Reading Lead Time of WRSZ              .
IF_EX_LISTING_PREPACK_COMP     I LISTING_PREPACK_COMP          Listing of Components of Prepack Materials                  .
IF_EX_LISTING_SUBSEQUENT       I LISTING_PERIOD                Listing Period Within Subsequent Listing                    .
IF_EX_LIST_DISCONTINUATION     I LISTING_PARAMETER_SET         Controling Material Discontinuation                         .
IF_EX_LMBP_PAI_SCREEN_POST     I PAI_SCREEN_POST               Data processing on a standard screen                        .
IF_EX_LMBP_PBO_SCREEN_POST     I PBO_SCREEN_POST               Processing of screen layout before data display             .
IF_EX_LMBP_VERFPROF_MODIFY     I VERFPROF_MODIFY               Modification of Verification profile definition and values  .
IF_EX_LMBP_VERFVALUE_CHECK     I VERFVALUE_CHECK               Verification entry processing                               .
IF_EX_LMOB_VAS_ORDER_BADI      I DISPLAY_VAS_ORDER             Display relevant VAS Orders                                 .
IF_EX_LSO_CANCELREASONS_C      I GET_CANCELLATION_REASONS      Determination of Possible Cancellation Reasons              .
IF_EX_LSO_CHECK_BOOKING        I CHECK_BOOKING                 BadI for Checks When Prebooking/Booking/Replacing/Rebooking .
IF_EX_LSO_CHECK_BOOKING        I CHECK_CANCELLATION            BAdI for Checks on Participation Cancellation               .
IF_EX_LSO_CHECK_BOOKING        I SET_BOOKING_CHECKS            Activate/Deactivate Checks                                  .
IF_EX_LSO_COLLABORATION        I FILTER_ROOMS                  Filter: Participants in Rooms                               .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE01     I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Determine Person/Org.Unit Responsible for Correspondence    .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE01     I SET_OUTPUT_LANGUAGE           Set Output Language (in Dialog, Default Value)              .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE01     I SUPPRESS_AUTOMATIC_CORR       Suppress Automatic Correspondence Context-Dependent         .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE11     I GET_DFT_MAIL_OPTIONS          Specify Parameters for Mail Output (Default)                .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE11     I GET_MAIL_OPTIONS              Specify Parameters for Mail Output (Context-Dep.)           .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE11     I GET_SENDER_MAILADDRESS        Sender: Determine SAP Mail Address                          .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE11     I GET_SENDER_SMTPADDRESS        Sender: Determine Internet Mail Address                     .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE11     I SETUP_MAIN_DOCU               Determine How Main Document Is to Be Sent                   .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE12     I GET_MAIL_ADD_ATTACHMENT       Get Additional Information (for Attachment)                 .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE12     I GET_MAIL_BODY                 Get Correspondence (for Text Block)                         .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE41     I GET_OUTPUT_OPTIONS            Output Control Options: Customizing Adjustments             .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE41     I GET_RECIPIENT_OPTIONS         Output Control Options: Recipient-Specific Adjustments      .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE43     I CHANGE_PRINTPARAMS            Change Output Parameters of Print Workbench                 .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE43     I GET_COUNTRY_FOR_LANGU         Gets Country for Language                                   .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE43     I GET_SENDCONTROL               Specify Dispatch Control Options                            .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE43     I IS_ASYNCHRONOUS               Output Correspondence Directly After Creation               .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER                    Specify Sender                                              .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_EMAIL              Determine Internet mail address of sender                   .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_FAX                Determine sender's fax number                               .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_NAME               Determine sender's name                                     .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_PAGER              Determine sender's pager number                             .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_RMAIL              Determine sender's SAP mail address                         .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE44     I GET_SENDER_TELN               Determine sender's phone number                             .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE45     I GET_COMMUNICATION_DATA        Specify Communication Addresses                             .
IF_EX_LSO_CORRESPONDENCE46     I GET_ADDRESS_READER            Specify Link to Contact Address Management                  .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I CHECK_CONTEXT                 Checks whether context is complete and valid for output     .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I CREATE_REQUEST                Generates request for output of context                     .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I DELETE_REQUEST                Delete request for output of contexts                       .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I FINISH_CREATE                 End of correspondence generation                            .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I FINISH_PRINT                  End of correspondence output                                .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I INIT_CREATE                   Initialization of correspondence generation                 .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I INIT_PRINT                    Initialization of correspondence output                     .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT           I PRINT_REQUEST                 Output of request                                           .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT_FKK       I CREATE_REQUEST                Create Correspondence Request                               .
IF_EX_LSO_CRP_OUTPUT_FKK       I PRINT_REQUEST                 Print Correspondence Request                                .
IF_EX_LSO_EBO                  I FILTEREBO                     Filter Learning Objectives                                  .
IF_EX_LSO_FOLLOWUP             I SET_PROFICIENCY               Set Qualification Proficiency                               .
IF_EX_LSO_LEARNER_GET          I GET_ALERTS                    Editing Training Proposals of Learner in the Learning Portal.
IF_EX_LSO_LEARNER_GET          I GET_LEARNER                   Assignment Learner to User                                  .
IF_EX_LSO_LEARNER_SET          I SET_LEARNER                   Assignment of User to Learner (Reverse of get_learner)      .
IF_EX_LSO_PRICES               I LSO_PRICES                    Learning Solution: Fee and Assignment (Dialog Box)          .
IF_EX_LTRM_BIN_CORD_CHANGE     I CHANGE_BIN_COORDINATES        Change xyz-coordinates and zone of a bin                    .
IF_EX_LTRM_DURTN_MODIF         I DURTN_MODIF                   Total route duration modification                           .
IF_EX_LTRM_GRP_RQST_CHANGE     I CHANGE_GRP_REQUEST            Change Request Data                                         .
IF_EX_LTRM_INTER_DURTN         I INTER_DURTN                   Inter zone duration calculation                             .
IF_EX_LTRM_INTRA_SEQ           I INTRA_SEQ                     Change the bin sequence in the zone                         .
IF_EX_LTRM_METRIC_CALC         I METRIC_CALC                   Customer metric calculation                                 .
IF_EX_LTRM_MODE_SET            I MODE_SET                      Mode set in ABAP memory at run time                         .
IF_EX_LTRM_NODE_DTRM           I NODE_DTRM                     Influence the entries/exits for each pair of zones          .
IF_EX_LTRM_RQST_DISPATCH       I RQST_DISPATCH                 Dispatching of request items to Task Management             .
IF_EX_LTRM_RQST_GLOBL_SCAN     I RQST_GLOBL_SCAN               Release requests on user-defined criteria basis             .
IF_EX_LTRM_RSTYP_LOCAT         I RSTYP_LOCAT                   Default resource location                                   .
IF_EX_LTRM_RSTYP_LOCATION      I RSTYP_LOCATION                Set a real location of a resource                           .
IF_EX_LTRM_TASK_CREATION       I TASK_CREATION                 User determination of task to create                        .
IF_EX_LTRM_TASK_POST_MODF      I TASK_POST_MODIF               Enable event after task status change                       .
IF_EX_LTRM_TASK_SEL            I TASK_SELECT                   User defined task selection                                 .
IF_EX_LTRM_TO_RQST_CHANGE      I CHANGE_TO_REQUEST             Change Request Data                                         .
IF_EX_LTRM_ZONE_COMB_FLTR      I COMBIN_FILTER                 Zone combinations modifcation                               .
IF_EX_LUMER_BADI_ROUND_INT     I MODIFY_INPUTDATA              Modify Units of Measure in Sales Order                      .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I CROSS_DOCK_DISABLE            Disable Cross-Docking                                       .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I DOCUMENT_DATE_CHANGE          Determine Document Date and Time                            .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I FIFO_CHECK                    Determine FIFO Tolerance                                    .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I OPPORTUNISTIC_CANDIDATE_SELECTDetermine TO to be Cancelled in Opportunistic Cross-Docking .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I PALLETIZING_DATA_DEFINE       Determine Palletization Data                                .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I PLANNING_DOCUMENTS_MATCH      Determine Planning and Candidate Documents Matching         .
IF_EX_LXDCK_CROSS_DOCK         I PLAN_DECISION_SELECT_CHANGE   Determine Selected Plan Decision and Adjust Decision Qty    .
IF_EX_LXSER_SN_CAPTURE_RF      I SN_DECODE                     Extract serial number from a combined barcode               .
IF_EX_LXSER_SN_CAPTURE_RF      I SN_PRINT                      Start printing operation                                    .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_POST      I ACTIVITY_POST                 Enable event after activity creation or confirmation        .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I ACTIVITY_MOVE_DEST_CHANG      Change Destination in Movement Activity                     .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I ACTIVITY_SCHEDULE_CHANGE      Change Time Window and Destination in Scheduling Activity   .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I ACTIVITY_SCHEDULE_MOD_VALIDATEValidate Modification of Scheduling Activity                .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I ACTIVITY_SELECT_CHANGE        Change Activity Selection                                   .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I ACTIVITY_UPDATE_POST          Enable Event That Follows Activity Creation or Status Change.
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I SCHDL_PROFILE_SET             Change Default Scheduling Profile                           .
IF_EX_LXYRD_ACTIVITY_PROC      I VEHICLE_ATTRIBUTES_CHANG      Change Vehicle Priority, Type and Arrival/Departure Times   .
IF_EX_LXYRD_DOCUMENT_PROCESSIN I SHIPMENT_STATUS_UPDATE        Update shipment statuses                                    .
IF_EX_MAPPING_RUNTIME          I CALL_RUNTIME                  Partner Mapping Runtime Call                                .
IF_EX_MAP_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENT   I MAP_FIN_TO_CHARACTERISTIC     Mapping of Transfer Structure to Acct Assignment Manager    .
IF_EX_MASS_CUSTOM_BUTTON       I CUSTOM_EINE_SELECT            Custom selection for EINE - EINA                            .
IF_EX_MASS_CUSTOM_BUTTON       I CUSTOM_EKKO_SELECT            Custom Selection for EKKO - EKPO - EKET                     .
IF_EX_MASS_CUSTOM_BUTTON       I CUSTOM_MARC_SELECT            Custom Selection for MARC - WRPL - MPOP                     .
IF_EX_MASS_CUSTOM_BUTTON       I CUSTOM_VENDOR_SELECT          Custom Selection for LFM2                                   .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I FILTER_USERS_CORRECTION_LIST  Filters save errors list                                    .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_EINE_CUSTOM_SAVE         Allows users to act after the save of mass EINE             .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_EINE_CUSTOM_VALIDATION   Makes customer validations for EINE                         .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_EINE_UPDATE_FIELD_CATALOGAllows users to make changes on specifc fields display      .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_EKKO_CUSTOM_VALIDATION   Makes customer validations for EKKO                         .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_EKKO_UPDATE_FIELD_CATALOGAllows users to make changes on specifc fields display      .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_LFM2_CUSTOM_SAVE         Allows users to act after the save                          .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_LFM2_CUSTOM_VALIDATION   Makes customer validations                                  .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_LFM2_UPDATE_FIELD_CATALOGAllows users to make changes on specifc fields display      .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_MARC_CUSTOM_SAVE         Allows users to act after the save of mass MARC             .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_MARC_CUSTOM_VALIDATION   Makes customer validations for MARC                         .
IF_EX_MASS_MNT_USER_EXIT       I MASS_MARC_UPDATE_FIELD_CATALOGAllows users to make changes on specifc fields display      .
IF_EX_MATERIAL_REFERENCE       I CREATE_MATERIAL               Material Will Be Created/Extended                           .
IF_EX_MATGRP_HIERARCHY_UPD     I AT_ACTIVATION_CHECK           Method when activating the article hierarchy (prod.h.check) .
IF_EX_MATGRP_HIERARCHY_UPD     I AT_ACTIVATION_SAVE            Method when activating the article hierarchy (prod.h.save)  .
IF_EX_MATGRP_HIERARCHY_UPD     I AT_CHANGE_CHECK               Method when copying the article hierarchy changes (prod.h.) .
IF_EX_MATGRP_HIERARCHY_UPD     I AT_CHANGE_SAVE_NODE           Method when copying the article hierarchy changes (prod.h.) .
IF_EX_MATGRP_HIERARCHY_UPD     I AT_CHANGE_SAVE_SKU            Method when copying the article hierarchy changes (prod.h.) .
IF_EX_MATGRP_SKU_UPD           I SKU_IN_MATMAIN_AT_CHECK       Update Article Master Data to Article or Product Hierarchy  .
IF_EX_MATGRP_SKU_UPD           I SKU_IN_MATMAIN_AT_SAVE        Update Article Master Data to Article or Product Hierarchy  .
IF_EX_MAT_SELECTION_CK         I ON_MATERIAL_SELECTION         Change Material Properties                                  .
IF_EX_MAT_UPLOAD_DATA          I SAVE_CUSTOMER_DATA            Update Customer-Specific Data                               .
IF_EX_MAT_UPLOAD_SAVE_IDOC     I MAP_CUSTOMER_DATA_ART         Transfer Customer-Specific Data to IDOC (Type)              .
IF_EX_MAT_UPLOAD_SAVE_IDOC     I MAP_CUSTOMER_DATA_MAT         Transfer Customer-Specific Data to IDOC (Mat)               .
IF_EX_MBP_ADD_LIST_FIELDS      I FIELD_TYPE_GET                Field Type Definition                                       .
IF_EX_MBP_ADD_LIST_FIELDS      I FILL_CLP                      Fill Additional Fields: Market Basket -" Pricing            .
IF_EX_MBP_ADD_LIST_FIELDS      I FILL_MBP                      Fill Additional Fields: Pricing -" Market Basket            .
IF_EX_MBP_ADD_LIST_FIELDS      I INPUT                         Reaction at Data Entry                                      .
IF_EX_MBP_ADD_LIST_FIELDS      I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Display Additional Fields                                   .
IF_EX_MB_BAPI_GOODSMVT_CREATE  I EXTENSIONIN_TO_MATDOC         Population of Customers' Own Fields from ExtensionIn        .
IF_EX_MB_BATCH_MASTER          I MAINTAIN_INSPECTION_DATE      Set Next Inspection Date                                    .
IF_EX_MB_CHECK_LINE_BADI       I CHECK_LINE                    Check Line Before Copying to Blocking Tables                .
IF_EX_MB_CIN_LMBMBU04          I CREATE_EXCISE_DOCUMENTS       create excise documents                                     .
IF_EX_MB_CIN_MM07MFB7          I MB_CIN_GRPOPUP                method for pop up in GR to capture excise invoice           .
IF_EX_MB_CIN_MM07MFB7_QTY      I SET_QUANTITY_IN_GR            default qty in GR                                           .
IF_EX_MB_CROSS_SYSTEM_SAP      I DATA_SEND_TO_RECEIVER         Send Data to Recipient                                      .
IF_EX_MB_CROSS_SYSTEM_SAP      I KEEP_REFERENCE_TO_PO          Hold Reference to Purchase Order?                           .
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_BADI         I MB_DOCUMENT_BEFORE_UPDATE     Exit After Writing a Material Document. Not in 'update task'.
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_BADI         I MB_DOCUMENT_UPDATE            When Writing a Material Document. In 'Update task'          .
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_BADI_SAP     I MB_DOCUMENT_BEFORE_UPDATE     Creation of a Material Document.   Not in 'Update Task'     .
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_BADI_SAP     I MB_DOCUMENT_CHANGE            Changing of a Material Document.    In 'Update Task'        .
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_BADI_SAP     I MB_DOCUMENT_UPDATE            Creation of a Material Document.    In 'Update Task'        .
IF_EX_MB_DOCUMENT_UPDATE       I MB_DOCUMENT_UPDATE            Business Add-In in Update of MKPF and MSEG                  .
IF_EX_MB_DOC_BADI_INTERNAL     I MB_DOCUMENT_BEFORE_UPDATE     Exit After Writing a Material Document. Not in 'update task'.
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_CALL_GET_MSEG_GI_GR_MIGO  Invocation of WRF_GET_MSEG_GI_GR from MIGO                  .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_CHANGE_STOCK_DETERMINATIONChanges the Result of Stock Determination                   .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_CHECK_PRICE_GOODS_MOVEMENTPrice Test: Submitter/Receiver from MB_CREATE_GOODS_MOVEMENT.
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_CHECK_PRICE_STRUCT_ARTICLEPrice Test: Structured Material                             .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_CHECK_STRUCT_ARTICLE_VAL  Check Valuation of Structured Material                      .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_DETERMINE_MVT_TYPE_IMSEG  Set Movement Type IMSEG Based on SOBKZ and CONS_ORDER       .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_CALLER                Return Calling Program of Stock Determination               .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_CSGMT_MVT_STRUCT_ART  Determine Movement Type of Structured Material              .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_CUST_CSGMT_HND        Customizing: Consignment Control                            .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_CUST_CSGMT_PRICE_CHECKCustomizing: Read Consignment Price Test for Movement Type  .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_CUST_CSGMT_STOCK_RULE Customizing: Read Cons. Stock Determination Rule for Plant  .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_GET_MSEG_GI_GR            Determine Vendor and Special Stock Type                     .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_SET_EKPO_STOCK_TYPE       Set Flag for Consignment Processing in Purchase Order       .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_SET_EXT_EBEFU             Sets Enhancement on Purchasing Fields in Inventory Mgmt     .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_SET_MSEG_GI_GR            SOBKZ and LIFNR Will Be Saved Globally                      .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_SET_UPDATE_EKPO           Order Update: No Invoice Receipt                            .
IF_EX_MB_ME_CSGMT_BADI_SAP     I WRF_SET_VBUP                  Set Billing Document Status in VBUP                         .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I CHECK_HEADER                  Check Header Data of Goods Movement                         .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I CHECK_ITEM                    Check Item Data of Goods Movement                           .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I HOLD_DATA_DELETE              Delete Held Data                                            .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I HOLD_DATA_LOAD                Load Held Data                                              .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I HOLD_DATA_SAVE                Save Held Data                                              .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I INIT                          Initialization and Registration of Ext. Detail Screens      .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I LINE_DELETE                   Delete a Line (GOITEM)                                      .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I LINE_MODIFY                   Add / Change a Line (GOITEM)                                .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I MODE_SET                      Mode of Transaction MIGO (Action / Reference Document)      .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I PAI_DETAIL                    PAI of Detail Screen                                        .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I PAI_HEADER                    PAI of Header Screen                                        .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I PBO_DETAIL                    PBO of Detail Screen                                        .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I PBO_HEADER                    PBO of Header Screen                                        .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I POST_DOCUMENT                 Post Goods Movement                                         .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I PUBLISH_MATERIAL_ITEM         Publish Item Data After Processing                          .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I RESET                         MIGO Reset (Delete All Internal Data)                       .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_BADI             I STATUS_AND_HEADER             Status Information and Header Data                          .
IF_EX_MB_MIGO_ITEM_BADI        I ITEM_MODIFY                   Change a Row from Certain Fields (GOITEM)                   .
IF_EX_MB_PHYSINV_INTERNAL      I CHECK_CALC_DONE               Check Whether Calculation of Book Inventory Was Performed   .
IF_EX_MB_PHYSINV_INTERNAL      I CHECK_CALC_ITEM               Check Whether Calc. of Book Inventory Was Performed For Item.
IF_EX_MB_PHYSINV_INTERNAL      I CHECK_TCODE                   Check Transaction Code                                      .
IF_EX_MB_PHYSINV_INTERNAL      I GET_POSTING_FLAG              Determine Whether Data Needs To Be Posted                   .
IF_EX_MB_PHYSINV_INTERNAL      I GET_TIMESTAMPS                Determine Count Time and Firming Time Fence                 .
IF_EX_MB_QUAN_CHECK_BADI       I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Item Data at Time of Quantity Check                         .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_BADI      I DATA_CHECK                    mb21/mb22: Check with Dialog Data                           .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_BADI      I DATA_MODIFY                   mb21/mb22: Complete and Correct from Dialog Data            .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_SCR       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport Data (from Screen)                                .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_SCR       I GET_XCONFIRM_FROM_SCREEN      Set Change Flag in Case of Data Change                      .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_SCR       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Data (to Screen)                                  .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_UPCHD     I MB_CHANGE_RESERVATION         Changing of Manual Reservations                             .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_UPCHD     I MB_CHANGE_RESERVATION_ARRAY   Changing of Reservations (Array Update)                     .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_UPCHD     I MB_CREATE_RESERVATION         Creation of Manual Reservations                             .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_UPCHD     I MB_DELETE_RESERVATION         Deletion of Reservations                                    .
IF_EX_MB_RESERVATION_UPCHD     I MB_DELETE_RESERVATION_ARRAY   Deletion of Several Reservations (Array-Delete, MBVR)       .
IF_EX_MB_RES_BAPI_CHANGE       I EXTENSIONIN_TO_RESB           Change Reservation Fields                                   .
IF_EX_MB_RES_BAPI_CREATE1      I EXTENSIONIN_TO_RESB           Adopt Customer's Own Fields as Reservation Fields           .
IF_EX_MB_RES_BAPI_DETAIL1      I RESDATA_TO_EXTENSIONOUT       Display Customer's Own Fields in Reservations               .
IF_EX_MB_STOR_LOC_BADI_GTS     I CHANGE_STOR_LOC_GTS           Change Storage Location "-" Customs SLoc - for GTS Fct. Only.
IF_EX_MCEX                     I CHECK_CHANGES_ALLOWED         Check If Changes are Allowed                                .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I DELETE_SETUPTABLE             Delete Setup Tables                                         .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I DISPLAY_LOG                   Display Log                                                 .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I DISPLAY_LOG_CONTINUE          Display Log (Subsequent Screen)                             .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I FILL_DATA                     Fill Data in Extractor                                      .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I FILL_EVENT                    Fill Event                                                  .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I GENERATE_ESTRUC               Generate Extract Structure                                  .
IF_EX_MCEX                     I MODIFY_MCS01                  Complete Characteristics in Brackets                        .
IF_EX_MCEX_45_CWB_ADD_ON       I MAPPING_MC45W_0CWB            Fill Extractor                                              .
IF_EX_MCEX_AB_DATA_ENHANCE     I DATA_ENHANCEMENT_CS           Data Enhancement for Customer Enhancement                   .
IF_EX_MDATA_TEMPLATE_TEST      I TEST_TEMPLATE                 Test Master Data Template Category                          .
IF_EX_MDC_SUBSCR_ACL           I PROCESS_FUNCTION              Process by customer activated function in the log notif.    .
IF_EX_MDM_BUPA_INBOUND         I BEFORE_APPL_INBOUND           Enrich Idoc before the inbound is called                    .
IF_EX_MDOC_ACTION_ACL          I ACTION                        Follow-up action to meas. document action (cl_meas_doc_acl) .
IF_EX_MDS_ACT_OPTION_CHECK     I CHECK                         Additional Checks                                           .
IF_EX_MDS_CTRL_PPO             I CREATE_ORDER                  Creation of a PPO Request                                   .
IF_EX_MD_ADD_COL_EZPS          I ACTIVATE_ADD_COLUMNS          Activation and Naming of the Additional Columns             .
IF_EX_MD_ADD_COL_EZPS          I FILL_ADD_COLUMNS              Filling of the Additional Columns                           .
IF_EX_MD_ADD_COL_OVERVIEW      I ACTIVATE_ADD_COLUMNS          Activation and Naming of the Additional Columns             .
IF_EX_MD_ADD_COL_OVERVIEW      I FILL_ADD_COLUMNS              Filling of the Additional Columns                           .
IF_EX_MD_ADD_ELEMENTS          I ADD_CHANGE_ELEMENTS           Addition of Additional Requirements and Receipts            .
IF_EX_MD_ALTERN_EXPLOSION      I CALL_ALTERN_EXPLOSION         Calling Alternative BOM Explosion                           .
IF_EX_MD_ALTERN_EXPLOSION      I GET_ALTERN_CUOBJ              Defining an alternative characteristic value assignment     .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_CALENDAR       I DETERMINE_CALENDAR_COVERAGE   Determination of an Alternative Calendar in Safety Time     .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_EBAN             Change data when importing purchase requisition             .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MARD             Change data when importing storage location/ plant stock    .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDBS             Change data when importing purchase order/ delivery sched.  .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDFA             Change data when importing production order                 .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDLA             Change data when importing shipping notification            .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDPB             Change data when importing planned independent requirements .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDQM             Change data when importing inspection lot                   .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDRI             Change data when importing total dependent requirements     .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDRS             Change data when importing dependent requ./ reservation     .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDSM             Change data when importing simulation requirements          .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDUA             Change data when importing ST purchase requisition release  .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDUB             Change data when importing ST purchase order release        .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDUP             Change data when importing ST planned order release         .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MDUR             Change data when importing stock transfer reservation       .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MSSA             Change data when importing sales order stock                .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MSSL             Change data when importing stock with subcontractor         .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_MSSQ             Change data when importing project stock                    .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_PLAF             Change data when importing planned order                    .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_SAUF             Change data when importing simulation planned order         .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_VBBE             Change data when importing individual requirements for SD   .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_VBBS             Change data when importing total requirements for SD        .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CHANGE_MDPSX_VFAPW            Change data when importing order in production plant        .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CONSIDER_CUSTCONSIGNMENT      Consider customer consigment for SD individual requirement  .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CONSIDER_OTHER_SD_TYPES       Consider additional sales requirements                      .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CONSIDER_RESB                 Consider dependent requirements/ reserv. in special cases   .
IF_EX_MD_CHANGE_MRP_DATA       I CONSIDER_THIRDPARTY           Consider third-party items from purchasing                  .
IF_EX_MD_DISPLAY_ELEMENT       I CHANGE_MDEZX_DELB0            Change display: Abbreviation for MRP element                .
IF_EX_MD_DISPLAY_ELEMENT       I CHANGE_MDEZX_EXTRA            Change display: MRP element data                            .
IF_EX_MD_EXPORT_TREE           I EXPORT_TREE                   Order Report: Export Contents of the Order Tree             .
IF_EX_MD_EXT_SUP               I GET_PLIFZ                     Determination of Planned Delivery Time                      .
IF_EX_MD_EXT_SUP               I GET_SUPPLYING_SL              Determination of Supplying Storage Location                 .
IF_EX_MD_INTERACT_PLANNING     I CHECK_MRP_ELEMENT_CHANGEABLE  Deactivating the Changeability of MRP elements              .
IF_EX_MD_LAST_LOT_EXACT        I IS_LAST_LOT_EXACT_ACTIVE      Method for Activating "Last Lot Exactly"                    .
IF_EX_MD_M61R_DELKZ_POPUP      I METHOD_DELKZ_POPUP            Popup: Data for MRP Element                                 .
IF_EX_MD_M61R_EXT_REQS_TXT     I METHOD_TEXT_GET               Display Data for MRP Element                                .
IF_EX_MD_M61X_EXT_REQS_GET     I METHOD_REQS_GET               Selection of External Requirements in Table MDPSX           .
IF_EX_MD_MODIFY_PRODVERS       I MODIFY_PRODUCTION_VERSION     Method for customer-defined determination of prod. version  .
IF_EX_MD_MODIFY_SOURCE         I MODIFY_SOURCE_OF_SUPPLY       Method for customer-specific source determination           .
IF_EX_MD_MODIFY_SOURCE         I MODIFY_VALIDITY_DATE          Method for changing the test date for the order book        .
IF_EX_MD_MRP_LIST              I EVALUATE_MRP_LIST             Further Processing of MRP List                              .
IF_EX_MD_MRP_PARAMETERS        I ADJUST_MATERIAL_MASTER_PARAMS Adjustment of Material Master Parameters                    .
IF_EX_MD_MRP_PARAMETERS        I ADJUST_PLANNING_PARAMS        Adjustment of Planning Parameters                           .
IF_EX_MD_MRP_RUN_PARALLEL      I SET_PACKAGE_SIZE              Set no. of Materials in Next Packet to be Planned           .
IF_EX_MD_PIR_FLEX_CONS         I CHECK_PIR_CONS_REDUC          Method for Checking Poss. of Consumption of MRP Elements    .
IF_EX_MD_PLANNING_RESULT       I COLLECT_MATERIAL_STATUS       Collect Status Messages for the Individual Materials        .
IF_EX_MD_PLANNING_RESULT       I POST_MATERIAL_STATUS          Display Status Messages for the Individual Materilas        .
IF_EX_MD_PLANNING_RESULT       I POST_PLANNING_RUN_STATUS      Display Status Messages for Total Planning                  .
IF_EX_MD_PLANNING_SCENARIO     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data transport of subscreen instance                        .
IF_EX_MD_PLANNING_SCENARIO     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport to Subscreen Instance                        .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_BOMEX_CIF      I DECIDE_MANDATORY_EXPL         Switch On/Off Forced Explosion for Planned Order from APO   .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_CHANGE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_SAVE_MAN        Change Planned Orders: Manual Processing                    .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_CHANGE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_SAVE_MRP        Change Planned Orders: Requirements Planning                .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_POST           I POST_AFTER_SAVE_MAN           Update planned orders: Manual processing                    .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_POST           I POST_AFTER_SAVE_MRP           Update planned orders: Requirements planning                .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_SCHEDULING     I CHANGE_CM61S_TCX00            Planned Order: Change to Scheduling Parameter               .
IF_EX_MD_PLDORD_TIME_STAMP     I POST_TIME_STAMP_PROBLEM       Publication of Time Stamp Problems                          .
IF_EX_MD_PURREQ_CHANGE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_SAVE_CONV       Changes to Purchase Requisitions: Planned Order Conversion  .
IF_EX_MD_PURREQ_CHANGE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_SAVE_MRP        Changes to Purchase Requisition: Requirements Planning      .
IF_EX_MD_PURREQ_POST           I POST_AFTER_SAVE               Purchase Requisition Update                                 .
IF_EX_MD_PURREQ_REL_STRAT      I DEACT_REL_STRATEGY_CHECK      Deactivation of Release Strategy Check for MRP Purchase Reqs.
IF_EX_MD_STOCK_TRANSFER        I CALC_REQUIREMENTS_DATE        Change to reqmnt date for stock transfer order proposals    .
IF_EX_MD_SUBCONT_LOGIC         I IS_GENERAL_SUBCON_LOGIC_ACTIVEDetermine whether general subcontracting logic is used      .
IF_EX_ME59_EXCLUDE             I ME59_CHECK_EXCLUSION          Check Purchase Requisition for ME59 Exclusion               .
IF_EX_MEGUI_LAYOUT             I CHANGE_VIEWS                  Change Structure of Views                                   .
IF_EX_MEGUI_LAYOUT             I TITLEBAR                      Change Title Bar                                            .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST          I INBOUND                       Inbound Mapping                                             .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST          I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Mapping                                            .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_ACCOUNT_IN                Eingangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Kont.  .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_ACCOUNT_OUT               Ausgangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Kont.  .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_HEADER_IN                 Eingangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Kopf   .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_HEADER_OUT                Ausgangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Kopf   .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_ITEM_IN                   Eingangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Pos.   .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_CUST_01       I MAP_ITEM_OUT                  Ausgangsverarbeitung für nicht zeichenartige Felder: Pos.   .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_IBS           I INBOUND                       Inbound Processing                                          .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_IBS           I MAP2E_IS2ERP                  Outbound Processing for IS2ERP Projects                     .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_IBS           I MAP2I_IS2ERP                  Inbound Processing for IS2ERP Projects                      .
IF_EX_MEOUT_BAPI_IBS           I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Processing                                         .
IF_EX_MEREP_RSLTHNDL2          I ADDITIONAL_HANDLING_POST      BAdI definition for Customers (Post)                        .
IF_EX_MEREP_RSLTHNDL2          I ADDITIONAL_HANDLING_PRE       BAdI definition for Customers (Pre)                         .
IF_EX_MEREP_RUNTM_LD2          I ADDITIONAL_FUNCTION           BAdI Method for Runtime Loader                              .
IF_EX_MESSAGES_RFW             I GET_LOG_IDENTIFIER            Get the application identifier for creating the log.        .
IF_EX_METH_FOBU_CONNECTOR      I GET                           Get application-specific fields and functions               .
IF_EX_METH_FOEV_CONNECTOR      I EVALUATE                      Get field value                                             .
IF_EX_ME_ARC_ACTIVE            I IS_ACTIVE                     Invocation of New Archiving Functionality                   .
IF_EX_ME_BADI_DISPLAY_DOC      I ME_DISPLAY_DOCUMENT           Realization of a Changed Transaction Code                   .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I EXTENSIONIN                   Process Industry-Specific Data via Extension in Parameter   .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I EXTENSIONOUT                  Process-Industry-Specific Data for ExtensionOut Parameter   .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I INBOUND                       Inbound Mapping                                             .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Mapping                                            .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I TEXT_OUTPUT                   Output Item/Header Texts                                    .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_01     I TEXT_SELECTION                Perform Dynamic Text Selection from BAPI                    .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_02     I INBOUND                       Inbound Processing of BAPI Interface Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_02     I MAP2E_EXTENSIONOUT            Outbound Mapping of ExtensionOut                            .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_02     I MAP2I_EXTENSIONIN             Inbound Mapping of ExtensionIn                              .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_02     I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Processing of BAPI Interface Data                  .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PO_CREATE_02     I TEXT_OUTPUT                   Define Text Output                                          .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_01     I EXTENSIONIN                   Method for Importing IS-ExtensionIn Data                    .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_01     I EXTENSIONOUT                  Method for Transfer of IS Data in ExtensionOut              .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_01     I INBOUND                       Method for Changing Import Data of Enjoy PReq BAPI          .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_01     I OUTBOUND                      Method for Changing Export Data of Enjoy PReq BAPI          .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_02     I INBOUND                       Method for Changing Import Data of Enjoy PReq BAPI          .
IF_EX_ME_BAPI_PR_CREATE_02     I OUTBOUND                      Method for Changing Export Data of Enjoy PReq BAPI          .
IF_EX_ME_BSART_DET             I BSART_DETERMINE               Determination of Document Type                              .
IF_EX_ME_CCP_ACTIVE_CHECK      I IS_ACTIVE                     Check Whether CCP Process Active                            .
IF_EX_ME_CCP_BESWK_AUTH_CH     I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Check Authorization                                         .
IF_EX_ME_CCP_BSART_DET         I BSART_DETERMINE               Determination of Document Type                              .
IF_EX_ME_CCP_DEL_DURATION      I DURATION_GET                  Determination of Delivery Date                              .
IF_EX_ME_CHANGE_CHARACTER      I ADD_CHARACTERISTICS           Transfer Cust.-Spec. Characterisctics for Prod. Allocation  .
IF_EX_ME_CHANGE_OUTTAB         I FILL_OUTTAB                   Enrich ALV Output Table                                     .
IF_EX_ME_CHDOC_ACTIVE          I IS_ACTIVE                     Query Activation                                            .
IF_EX_ME_CHECK_ALL_ITEMS       I RECALCULATE_ITEMS             Run Through Items Again After Changes in Header             .
IF_EX_ME_CHECK_OA              I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_EX_ME_CHECK_OA              I SAVE                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_CHECK_SOURCES         I CHECK_DURING_SEARCH           Additional Checks During Source Determination               .
IF_EX_ME_CHECK_SOURCES         I CHECK_DURING_STD_CHECK        Additional Checks During Source of Supply Check             .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2R          I ME_CIN_CVD_IN_GR              CIN - Get CVD in GR                                         .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2R          I ME_CIN_DELIVERY_CHARGES       CIN Delivery charges                                        .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2V          I ME_CIN_FETCH_EXCISE_INVOICE   Fetch excise invoice for all items                          .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2V          I ME_CIN_FETCH_EXCISE_INV_ITEM  Fetch excise invoice when item is present in selection      .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2V          I ME_CIN_FETCH_EXCISE_INV_MEPRF Fetch excise invoice for price                              .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_LEINRF2V          I ME_CIN_PICK_GR_FOR_EXCISE     Select GR for the excise invoice entered                    .
IF_EX_ME_CIN_MM06EFKO          I ME_CIN_COPY_PO_DATA           Copy PO data for CIN                                        .
IF_EX_ME_CIP_ALLOW_CHANGE      I GET_DISPLAY                   Gets Display/Change Indicator                               .
IF_EX_ME_CIP_REF_CHAR          I GET_APPLICATION_INPUT         Reads the Tables That Supply the Reading Obj. Characterists..
IF_EX_ME_CIP_REF_CHAR          I SET_APPLICATION_DATA          Changes the Item Data from the Writing Obj. Characteristics .
IF_EX_ME_COMMITMENT_RETURN     I IS_ACTIVE                     Check if commitments for return item is active              .
IF_EX_ME_COMMITMENT_STO_CH     I IS_ACTIVE                     Check if commitments for Stock Transfer Order is active     .
IF_EX_ME_COMMITMNT_PARKING     I REDEFINE_OIINTERFACE_CALL     Suppression of Commitment Call When Parking Requisition/PO  .
IF_EX_ME_COMMTMNT_PO_RELEV     I CHECK_RELEV                   Check Commitment-Relevance for Purchase Order               .
IF_EX_ME_COMMTMNT_PO_REL_C     I CHECK_RELEV                   Check Commitment-Relevance for Purchase Order               .
IF_EX_ME_COMMTMNT_REQ_RELE     I CHECK_RELEV                   Check Commitment Relevance of Purchase Requisition          .
IF_EX_ME_COMMTMNT_REQ_RE_C     I CHECK_RELEV                   Check Commitment Relevance of Purchase Requisition          .
IF_EX_ME_DEFINE_CALCTYPE       I DEFINE_CALCTYPE               Determine Pricing Type in Case of Changes in EKKO, EKPO     .
IF_EX_ME_DOC_FOLLOW_ON_PROCESS I DELIVERY_FROM_PO_ITEMS        Change Data Prior to Transfer to Delivery                   .
IF_EX_ME_DOC_FOLLOW_ON_PROCESS I DETERMINE_PLANT               Change in 'Own Logical System' Indicator                    .
IF_EX_ME_DOC_FOLLOW_ON_PROCESS I INVOICE_FROM_PO_ITEM          Change Data Prior to Transfer to Invoice Verification       .
IF_EX_ME_DP_CLEARING           I CHECK_CLEARING                Checks and Selects Records That Have to be Cleared          .
IF_EX_ME_DP_CLEARING           I NEW_EKBE_LINES                Passes New EKBE Records to BAdI                             .
IF_EX_ME_FIELDSTATUS_STOCK     I MODIFY_FIELDSTATUS_PO         Change Field Status for Warehouse Orders                    .
IF_EX_ME_FIELDSTATUS_STOCK     I MODIFY_FIELDSTATUS_PR         Change Field Status for Warehouse Requisitions              .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I EXECUTE                       Treatment of Function Codes                                 .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I MAP_DYNPRO_FIELDS             Build Up Field Catalog                                      .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I SUBSCRIBE                     Publisch Customer's Own Screens                             .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I TRANSPORT_FROM_DYNP           Data Transport from Screen                                  .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I TRANSPORT_FROM_MODEL          Data Transport from Business Object                         .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I TRANSPORT_TO_DYNP             Data Transport to Screen                                    .
IF_EX_ME_GUI_PO_CUST           I TRANSPORT_TO_MODEL            Data Transport to Business Object                           .
IF_EX_ME_HOLD_PO               I IS_ALLOWED                    Deactivate "Hold Purchase Order" Function Key               .
IF_EX_ME_INFOREC_CHG_SCHED_DAT I REFERENCE_SCHED_DATA          Reference Handling for Scheduling Data                      .
IF_EX_ME_INFREC_ARCHIVING      I INTLINK_ARCHIVING             Delete the interlinkage from the Miniplatform.              .
IF_EX_ME_INFREC_ARCHIVING      I IS_MSI_ACTIVE                 Check if the Miniplatform is activated.                     .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I CHANGE_CONFIRMATION_TYPE      Change in Confirmation Category                             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_CONF_CONTROL          Processing of Confirmation Control Data (T163G)             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_IDOC_DATA_IN          Inbound Processing of IDoc Data                             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_IDOC_DATA_OUT         Outbound Processing of IDoc Data                            .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_PRICE_TOLERANCE       Processing of Price Tolerances (Maximum/Minimum Price)      .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_SEGMENT               Processing of a Segment                                     .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_TEXT                  Processing of Texts and Setting of Update Indicator         .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I PROCESS_VEND_MATERIAL         Processing of Vendor Material                               .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM            I SET_MESSAGE_STATUS            Set Status for Tolerance Messages                           .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I CHANGE_CONFIRMATION_TYPE      Change in Confirmation Category                             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_CONF_CONTROL          Processing of Confirmation Control Data (T163G)             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_IDOC_DATA_IN          Inbound Processing of IDoc Data                             .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_IDOC_DATA_OUT         Outbound Processing of IDoc Data                            .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_PRICE_TOLERANCE       Processing of Price Tolerances (Maximum/Minimum Price)      .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_SEGMENT               Processing of a Segment                                     .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_TEXT                  Process Texts                                               .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I PROCESS_VEND_MATERIAL         Processing of Vendor Material                               .
IF_EX_ME_MMPUR_EINM_CUST       I SET_MESSAGE_STATUS            Set Status for Tolerance Messages                           .
IF_EX_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS       I SET_SCM_PIC_DFPS              Decision re PIC in SCM - with Advice Code                   .
IF_EX_ME_PIC_MODIFY_DFPS       I SET_SCM_PIC_ROUNDING_DFPS     Confirm Whole Units Only - with Advice Code                 .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP           I FIELDCAT_CHANGE               Change Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP           I HANDLE_HOTSPOT_CLICK          Treatment of "Double-Click Events"                          .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP           I OUTTAB_CHANGE                 Change Outputted Lines                                      .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP_CUST      I FIELDCAT_CHANGE               Change Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP_CUST      I HANDLE_HOTSPOT_CLICK          Treatment of "Double-Click Events"                          .
IF_EX_ME_POHIST_DISP_CUST      I OUTTAB_CHANGE                 Change Outputted Lines                                      .
IF_EX_ME_POST_HISTORY          I ME_POST_HISTORY               Badi for FB ME_POST_HISTORY (Triggering of Follow-On Action).
IF_EX_ME_PO_PRICING            I PROCESS_KOMK                  Processing of Header Data for Price Determination (KOMK)    .
IF_EX_ME_PO_PRICING            I PROCESS_KOMP                  Processing of Item Data for Price Determination (KOMP)      .
IF_EX_ME_PO_PRICING_CUST       I PROCESS_KOMK                  Processing of Header Data for Price Determination (KOMK)    .
IF_EX_ME_PO_PRICING_CUST       I PROCESS_KOMP                  Processing of Item Data for Price Determination (KOMP)      .
IF_EX_ME_PO_SC_SRV             I MAINTAIN_SRV_FOR_SC           Service tab page for subcontracting item                    .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_COMP          I CHANGE_QUANTITY               Change Component Quantity                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I OPEN                          Opening of an Outline Agreement                             .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Account Assignment Data                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT           I PROCESS_SCHEDULE              Processing of Delivery Schedule Line Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I OPEN                          Opening of an Outline Agreement                             .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Account Assignment Data                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_OUT_CUST      I PROCESS_SCHEDULE              Processing of Delivery Schedule Line Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I DELETION_ACCOUNT              Deletion of Account Assignment Lines                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FIELDSELECTION_ACCOUNT        Special Field Selection Account Assignment                  .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I FINALIZE                      Changes Before Check                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I MANUAL_SUBITEM_ALLOWED        Check Whether SLS Items Allowed                             .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I OPEN                          Open a Purchase Order                                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Account Assignment Data                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO            I PROCESS_SCHEDULE              Processing of Delivery Schedule Line Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I OPEN                          Open a Purchase Order                                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Account Assignment Data                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_PO_CUST       I PROCESS_SCHEDULE              Processing of Delivery Schedule Line Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I DELETION_ACCOUNT              Delete Multiple Account Assignment Lines                    .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I FIELDSELECTION_ACCOUNT        Special Field Selection Account Assignment                  .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I OPEN                          Open a Purchase Requisition                                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Delivery Schedule Line Data                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ           I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I CLOSE                         Closing Processing                                          .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER         Special Field Selection Header                              .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_HEADER_REFKEYS Field Selection Reference Key Document Header               .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM           Special Field Selection Item                                .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I FIELDSELECTION_ITEM_REFKEYS   Field Selection Reference Key Document Item                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I INITIALIZE                    Initializations (Invoked Once Only)                         .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I OPEN                          Open a Purchase Requisition                                 .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I PROCESS_ACCOUNT               Processing of Account Assignment Data                       .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I PROCESS_HEADER                Processing of Header Data                                   .
IF_EX_ME_PROCESS_REQ_CUST      I PROCESS_ITEM                  Processing of Item Data                                     .
IF_EX_ME_PURCHDOC_POSTED       I POSTED                        Purchasing Document Posted                                  .
IF_EX_ME_RELEASE_CREATE        I AFTER_CREATION                Change Data After Release Creation                          .
IF_EX_ME_RELEASE_CREATE        I BEFORE_CREATION               Change Data Before Release Creation                         .
IF_EX_ME_REQ_APPROVAL          I BUYER_APPROVAL                Control of Buyer Approval                                   .
IF_EX_ME_REQ_HEADER_TEXT       I COPY_HEADER_TEXT              Copy Header Text                                            .
IF_EX_ME_REQ_NEW_VERSION       I CHECK_NEW_VERSION             Check new Version                                           .
IF_EX_ME_REQ_OI_EXT            I IS_REQUESTED                  Commitment Update Desired                                   .
IF_EX_ME_REQ_POSTED            I POSTED                        Purchase Requisition Posted                                 .
IF_EX_ME_TAX_FROM_ADDRESS      I GET_TXJCD                     Tax Jurisdiction Code from Delivery Address                 .
IF_EX_ME_TAX_FROM_ADDRESS      I SERVICES_TXJCD                Tax Jurisdiction Code from Delivery Address for Service     .
IF_EX_ME_TRIGGER_ATP           I TRIGGER_ATP                   Sets a flag to trigger the availability check               .
IF_EX_ME_WRF_STD_DNG           I STD_DNG_CHECK                 Remind and Expedite: Change Reminder Date                   .
IF_EX_ME_WRF_STD_DNNG          I FASHION_DUNNING_CHECK         Remind and Expedite: Change Reminder/Expediting Date        .
IF_EX_MGMT_DEV_HISTORY         I DELETE_HISTORY_DATA           Deletion of History Data                                    .
IF_EX_MGNT_DEVICENAME_GEN      I GENERATE_DEVICENAME           generates a new speakable Devicename                        .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I CHANGE_FIELDSELECTION         Change Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I CHANGE_FIELDTAB               Determination of Relevant Fields                            .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I CHANGE_VALUES                 Customer-Defined Copying Rules                              .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I CHECK_INPUT                   Matrix Entry Check                                          .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I GET_CURSOR                    Cursor from Subscreen from Customer Program                 .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I GET_SETTINGS                  Program Settings                                            .
IF_EX_MGW_MTRX_MAINTENANCE     I SORT_MATRIX_AXIS              Resort Axis Assignment Once                                 .
IF_EX_MGW_PICTURE              I AFTER_PROCESSING              After Displaying Image/Series                               .
IF_EX_MGW_PICTURE              I CHANGE_OBJECT_SETTINGS        Check/Adjust Determined Object Characteristics              .
IF_EX_MGW_PICTURE              I CONVERT_OBJECT_TO_EXTERNAL    External Display of Object Number (URL)                     .
IF_EX_MGW_PICTURE              I DEFINE_OBJECT_SETTINGS        Check/Adjust Determined Object Characteristics              .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I AFTER_MATRIX_SENDING          Postprocessing Matrix Data                                  .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I BEFORE_MATRIX_SENDING         Transfer of Prices Before Matrix Processing                 .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I CHANGE_INFORECORD_DATA        Copy Customer-Specific Values in Info Record                .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I CHANGE_VALUES                 Execute Customer-Specific Function Codes                    .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I CHECK_INPUT                   Check Changed Fields                                        .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I COPY_VALUES                   Execute Customer-Specific Copy Rules                        .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I GET_CUSTOMER_MODE             Customer-Specific Modes                                     .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I GET_SETTINGS                  Change Control Parameters                                   .
IF_EX_MGW_PURCHPRICE_MATIX     I SORT_MATRIX_AXIS              Resort Axis Assignment Once                                 .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I AFTER_MATRIX_SENDING          Postprocessing Matrix Data                                  .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I BEFORE_MATRIX_SENDING         Transfer of Prices Before Matrix Processing                 .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I CHANGE_VALUES                 Execute Customer-Specific Function Codes                    .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I CHECK_INPUT                   Check Changed Fields                                        .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I COPY_VALUES                   Execute Customer-Specific Copy Rules                        .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I GET_CUSTOMER_MODE             Customer-Specific Modes                                     .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I GET_SETTINGS                  Change Control Parameters                                   .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I SORT_MATRIX_AXIS              Resort Axis Assignment Once                                 .
IF_EX_MGW_SALESPRICE_MATIX     I TRANSPORT_CALP                Transfer of New/Changed Price Calculation                   .
IF_EX_MG_MASS_NEWSEG           I ADD_NEW_SEGMENT               Get New Segments                                            .
IF_EX_MG_MASS_NEWSEG           I RETURN_IDOC_TYPE              Change Message Type and IDoc Type                           .
IF_EX_MILL_BEFORE_BATCH_CL     I MILL_BEFORE_BATCH_CL          Before Classification of GR Batch                           .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_DEACTIVATE_FCODES       Hide FCodes                                                 .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD1                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF1 for Stock Overview             .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD2                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF2 for Stock Overview             .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD3                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF3 for Stock Overview             .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD4                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF1 for Object List                .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD5                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF2 for Object List                .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_METHOD6                 Add-In Method for FCode +CF3 for Object List                .
IF_EX_MILL_CLMMBE_ADDIN1       I ADDIN_SET_LISTTYPE            Adopt Type of List in Instance                              .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I MOVE_TYPE_TRANSFER_GET        Determine Movement Type Not Set in Customizing              .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I REST_LINE_MODIFY              Change Remaining Row for Posting/Check                      .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I SCRAP_ABS_GET                 Determine Absolute Scrap Limit                              .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I SCRAP_MATERIAL_GET            Determine Scrap Material                                    .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I SCRAP_MATERIAL_NO_INPUT       Close Scrap Material Fields to Input                        .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I SCRAP_PCT_GET                 Determine Percentage Scrap Limit                            .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN1          I SELECTION_CRITERIA_MMCL_GET   Selection Criteria for Stock Overview Environment by Char.  .
IF_EX_MILL_CUT_ADDIN2          I ITEM_TABLES_HANDLE_EXTERNAL   Check of Issuing and Receiving Items                        .
IF_EX_MILL_PC_CHG_CLSF         I MILL_PC_AFTER_CHG_CLSF        Characteristics for Change/Calculate after Standard Call    .
IF_EX_MILL_PC_CHG_CLSF         I MILL_PC_BEFORE_CHG_CLSF       Character Chars Before Standard Call With Merge Function    .
IF_EX_MILL_PC_CHG_CLSF         I MILL_PC_GOODS_RECIPT          Characteristic Calculation for Goods Receipt                .
IF_EX_MILL_PC_CLSF_PRE         I MILL_PC_CLSF_COPY_CHAR        Copy Characteristics from Preceding Batch to Process Batch  .
IF_EX_MILL_REF_CHAR_PURCH      I PURCH_ORDER_FIELDS_ASSIGN     Assign Additional Fields from PO (contract, sched. agmt,...).
IF_EX_MILL_REF_CHAR_PURCH      I PURCH_REQ_FIELD_ASSIGN        Assign Additional Fields from Purchase Requisition          .
IF_EX_MILL_SOLL_IST_COMP       I GET_CHAR_TOLERANCE_EVALUATION Char. Value Assignment of Configuration and Classificat. PB .
IF_EX_MILL_SOLL_IST_COMP       I GET_EVALUATION_SINGLE_AFPO_PC Value Assignment of Order Item and Process Batch            .
IF_EX_MILL_SOLL_IST_COMP       I GET_TOTAL_EVALUATION          Value Assignment Display                                    .
IF_EX_MIXED_PP_QUANTITIES      I INITIAL_MIXED_PP_QUANTITIES   Preassign Weighting Factors for Vendor Mixed Price          .
IF_EX_MIXSHOPDATA_E            I MIXSHOPDATA                   Merge Shop                                                  .
IF_EX_MI_AUTH_RFC_001          I CHANGE_RFC_DES                Change RFC Destinations to Determine Permissions            .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_CHECK_E     I CHECK_CHAR_VAL                Check Manually Entered Char. Values in Material Maintenance .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I CHECK_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_WYT2    Check Characteristic Value for Vendor-Dep. Char. Value      .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I F4_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_WYT2       F4 Help for Vendor-Dependent Characteristic Values          .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I READ_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_MAKT     Read WRF_CHARVAL and WRF_CHARVALT to Generate Short Texts   .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I READ_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_MATRIX   Read WRF_CHARVAL and WRF_CHARVALT to Display Matrix         .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I READ_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_READ_FM  Read WRF_CHARVAL and WRF_CHARVALT for the Read Module       .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I READ_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_WMWP     Read WRF_CHARVAL for Value and Quota Bar                    .
IF_EX_MM4X_CHARVAL_READ_I      I READ_CHAR_VALUES_FOR_WYT2     Read WRF_CHARVAL and WRF_CHARVALT for Vendor-Dep. Char. Vals.
IF_EX_MM4X_PARENT_NODE_E       I ARTICLE_ASSIGNMENT_CHECK      Check New and Changed Node Assignments                      .
IF_EX_MM4X_PARENT_NODE_E       I ARTICLE_MAIN_ASSIGNM_CHECK    Check Main Assignment                                       .
IF_EX_MM4X_PARENT_NODE_E       I GET_PARENT_NODE_DATA          Determine Parent Node to Display                            .
IF_EX_MM4X_PARENT_NODE_E       I GET_TC_COLUMN_TEXT            Read Headers for Parent Node and Name                       .
IF_EX_MMSRV_ACC_SPLIT_SAP      I PROCESS_ACC_DATA              Process Account Assignment Data                             .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_ARCHIVE         I CHECK_ARCHIVABLE              Service Master: Prevent Archiving Steps                     .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_BAPI_CUST       I INBOUND                       Change Import Data                                          .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_BAPI_CUST       I OUTBOUND                      Change Export Data                                          .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_MAIN            I PROCESS_CUST_DATA             Check Customer Data                                         .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_MAIN            I PROCESS_SSC_DATA              Check Standard Service Catalog                              .
IF_EX_MMSRV_SM_NOTIFY          I NOTIFY                        Notification                                                .
IF_EX_MM_DELIVERY_ADDR_SAP     I ADDRESS_PROPOSE               Determine Delivery Address                                  .
IF_EX_MM_PRIO_ORG              I MRP_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE        Determine Organizational Priority During Reqmts Planning    .
IF_EX_MM_PRIO_ORG              I PO_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE         Determine Organizational Priority in Orders                 .
IF_EX_MM_PRIO_ORG              I PR_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE         Determine Organizational Priority in Purchase Requisitions  .
IF_EX_MM_PRIO_ORG              I RES_PRIO_ORG_DETERMINE        Determine Organizational Priority in Reservations           .
IF_EX_MPA_EXIT                 I REPLY_RECEIVED                Handle received reply of push message                       .
IF_EX_MPKC_REQ_SELECTION       I GET_ADDITIONAL_REQUIREMENTS   Provides Additional Requirements                            .
IF_EX_MRM_DRSEG_CUST_FIELD     I DETERMINE                     Redetermine Variance Type and Customer Fields               .
IF_EX_MRM_ERS_HDAT_CHANGE      I ERS_HEADERDATA_CHANGE         Change Header Fields                                        .
IF_EX_MRM_ERS_HDAT_MODIFY      I ERS_HEADERDATA_MODIFY         Change Header Fields                                        .
IF_EX_MRM_ERS_IDAT_MODIFY      I ERS_ITEMDATA_MODIFY           Change Document Lines                                       .
IF_EX_MRM_ERS_PDAT_CHANGE      I ERS_POSITIONDATA_CHANGE       Change Document Lines                                       .
IF_EX_MRM_HEADER_CHECK         I HEADERDATA_CHECK              Check of Header Data                                        .
IF_EX_MRM_HEADER_DEFAULT       I HEADER_DEFAULT_SET            Default Values for Header Fields in Invoice Verification    .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I CUSTOMDATA_MODIFY             Change Customer's Own Fields                                .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I CUSTOM_DATA_GET               Adopt Customer Data from Customer Screen                    .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I CUSTOM_DATA_TRANSFER          Data Transport from Customer Screen                         .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I INVOICE_DATA_GET              Adopt Invoice Data                                          .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I INVOICE_DATA_TRANSFER         Data Transport to Customer Screen                           .
IF_EX_MRM_ITEM_CUSTFIELDS      I TABPAGE_LABEL_SET             Set Label                                                   .
IF_EX_MRM_MRIS_HDAT_MODIFY     I MRIS_HEADERDATA_MODIFY        Change Header Fields                                        .
IF_EX_MRM_MRIS_IDAT_MODIFY     I MRIS_ITEMDATA_MODIFY          Change Document Lines                                       .
IF_EX_MRM_MRKO_HDAT_MODIFY     I MRKO_HEADERDATA_MODIFY        Change Vendor and Document Type                             .
IF_EX_MRM_PAYMENT_TERMS        I PAYMENT_TERMS_SET             Set Terms of Payment                                        .
IF_EX_MRM_RELEASE_CHECK        I DOCUMENT_CHECK_RELEASE        Additional Verification of Invoices Before Release          .
IF_EX_MRM_TOLERANCE_GROUP      I TOLERANCE_GROUP_SET           Set Vendor-Dependent Tolerance Group                        .
IF_EX_MRM_TRANSACT_DEFAULT     I TRANSACTION_DEFAULT_SET       Default Values for Invoice Verification                     .
IF_EX_MRM_UDC_DISTIBUTE        I AMOUNTS_CALCULATE             Calculation of Delivery Costs' Shares                       .
IF_EX_MRM_UDC_DISTRIBUTE       I AMOUNTS_CALCULATE             Calculation of Delivery Costs' Shares                       .
IF_EX_MRM_VARIANCE_TYPE        I DETERMINE                     Re-Determination of Variance Type and Customer's Owm Fields .
IF_EX_MRM_WT_SPLIT_UPDATE      I WHTAX_SPLIT_UPDATE            Change to Tables Withholding Tax and Vendor Split           .
IF_EX_MRO_CONTRACT             I MRO_CONTRACT_COMPONENT_CHECK  Contract Check for External Components                      .
IF_EX_MRO_CONTRACT             I MRO_CONTRACT_OPERATION_CHECK  Contract Check for External Operation                       .
IF_EX_MR_CIN_LMR1MI2G          I MR_CIN_GRLIVTAX               Method for copying GR for LIV tax                           .
IF_EX_MR_CIN_LMR1MI2G_SEL      I COPY_DRSEG_SELKZ              copy drseg selection                                        .
IF_EX_MR_CIN_MM08RFS0          I MR_CIN_IVTAX                  calculate excise in invoice verification                    .
IF_EX_MR_CIN_MM08RFX0          I CVD_GET_IN_IV                 Default CVD value in IV                                     .
IF_EX_MR_CIN_RMMR01RS          I STORE_BPOTAB                  Storing BPO table                                           .
IF_EX_MR_CONTEXT_MENU          I DISPATCH                      Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_MSI_MATGRP_TO_PCH_MAP    I MAP_MATGRP_TO_PCH             Mapping: Material Groups to Product Category Hierarchy      .
IF_EX_MSI_MATTYP_TO_PCH_MAP    I MAP_MATTYP_TO_PCH             Mapping: Material Types to Product Category Hierarchy       .
IF_EX_MSI_MAT_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_MAT_TO_PRD                Map material to product                                     .
IF_EX_MSI_MAT_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_PRD_TO_MAT                Map product to material                                     .
IF_EX_MSI_PIR_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_IL_TO_PIR                 MAP IL to PIR                                               .
IF_EX_MSI_PIR_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_PIR_TO_IL                 MAP PIR to IL                                               .
IF_EX_MSI_SERVTYP_TO_PCH_MAP   I MAP_SERVTYP_TO_PCH            Mapping: Service Types to Product Category Hierarchy        .
IF_EX_MSI_SRV_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_PRD_TO_SRV                Map product02  to service                                   .
IF_EX_MSI_SRV_PRD_MAPPING      I MAP_SRV_TO_PRD                Map Service to product 02                                   .
IF_EX_MURC_REPLACE_ERFME       I CHECK_1_2_1_ERROR_FREE        Check for Clarity of Conversion                             .
IF_EX_MYOBJ_CATS_UNAME         I AT_UNAME_DETERMINE            Determine UserNames from PERNR + SY-UNAME                   .
IF_EX_N1APPLAN_CHECK           I CHECK                         Method for Additional Checks of Appointment Plans           .
IF_EX_N1CREATE_SCREEN          I CREATE                        Create an Instance of a Screen Class                        .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ACTIONS_CALL_CODE             Time of External Coding Program Call (No Change)            .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ACTIONS_DIAGNOSIS             Time of Diagnosis Processing (No Changes)                   .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ACTIONS_OTHERS                Time of Various Others (No Changes)                         .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ACTIONS_SERVICES              Time of Service Processing (No Changes)                     .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ACTIONS_SETTINGS_GET          Time of Setting Determination (No Changes)                  .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CALL_CODE                     Address External Coding Program (e.g. DIACOS)               .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CALL_HELP                     Call Diagnoses / Services Input Help                        .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CHECK                         Check Data (Button Check or Before Save)                    .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CHECK_PREFIX_SVC              Service Prefix Check (Hide Services)                        .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CLASS_BOOK                    Update Classifications (Standard N1DCSCLASS)                .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CLASS_DETERMINATION           Transfer Classifications from DIACOS to Internal Table      .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I CLASS_SELECTION               Selection of Classifications (Standard from N1DCSCLASS)     .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I ORG_UNIT_POPUP                Ovreride OU/EmR Entry (Before Standard Function Module Call).
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SAVE_AFTER_BOOKING            After Updating Data                                         .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SAVE_FIRST_ACTIONS            Initial Action When Saving                                  .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SAVE_LAST_ACTIONS             Last Actions at End of Saving                               .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SERVICE_ADD_DATA_SHOW         Display Additional Data                                     .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SERVICE_PERFORM               Call Perform Service Function                               .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SERVICE_RELEASE               Call Release Service Function                               .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SETTINGS_COMMON_GET           Select Customer-Specific Settings                           .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I SET_GUI_STATUS                Fill Excluding Table                                        .
IF_EX_N1DCS_DIASVCQUICKENT     I USER_COMMAND                  Override User Command (Before Standard User Command Logic)  .
IF_EX_N1DISPOAP_SCHEDULED      I FILL_ASSIGNED_ORDERS          Fill Append Fields for Assigned Transport Orders            .
IF_EX_N1DISPOAP_SCHEDULED      I FILL_ORDERS_OUTST             Fill Append Fields for Outstanding Transport Orders         .
IF_EX_N1DISPOAP_SCHEDULED      I FILL_REQUEST                  Fill Append Fields for Requests                             .
IF_EX_N1DISPOAP_SCHEDULED      I FILL_SCHEDULED_ORDERS         Fill Appenf Fields for Scheduled Transport Orders           .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADMIN_EVT_SCR       I CREATE                        Create an Instance of the Customer-Specific Screen          .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADMIN_EV_SIMPLE     I AFTER_SAVE                    Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADMIN_EV_SIMPLE     I BEFORE_CHANGE                 Edit Data Before Change                                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADMIN_EV_SIMPLE     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Preset/Deactivate Dialog                                    .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADMIN_EV_SIMPLE     I BEFORE_SAVE                   Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I BEFORE_PROCESS_CALL           Before Process Call (Before Dialog Construction)            .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I CHECK                         Check data                                                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I CHECK_FOR_CHANGES             Has data changed?                                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I CREATE                        Constructing Control Logic                                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I DESTROY                       Exiting Dialog                                              .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I FILL_GUI_EXCLTAB              Exclude Table for Status of Admin. Event Framework          .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I PAI_CHANGE_DATA               Execute Data Changes After PAI (Before OK Code)             .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I SET_DEFAULTS                  Make/Change Data Presettings                                .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I SET_SELECTED_EVENTS           Specify Selected Events for Order                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_ADM_EVENT_DIAL      I USER_COMMAND                  Before Standard Function Code Processing Call               .
IF_EX_N1ME_BEFORE_DT_FSOU      I BEFORE_DT_FSOU                Change Parameter for Fill Source Determination              .
IF_EX_N1ME_CALC                I CHANGE_ODRUG                  Change Order Drug                                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_CALC                I CHANGE_ORATE                  Change Dosage Quantities of Infusions                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDEVENT     I AFTER_SAVE                    Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDEVENT     I BEFORE_CHANGE                 Edit Data Before Change                                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDEVENT     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Preset/Deactivate Dialog                                    .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDEVENT     I BEFORE_SAVE                   Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDORDER     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 BAdI for Presetting/Deactivating Dialog                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDORDER     I EVENTS_TO_CANCEL              Specify Which EVents Should Be Canceled                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDORDER     I EXIT_AFTER_SAVE               Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDORDER     I EXIT_BEFORE_END               Edit Data Before Ending                                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_ENDORDER     I EXIT_BEFORE_SAVE              Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EVSTATUS     I AFTER_SAVE                    Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EVSTATUS     I BEFORE_CHANGE                 Edit Data Before Change                                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EVSTATUS     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Preset/Deactivate Dialog                                    .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EVSTATUS     I BEFORE_SAVE                   Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EXTEND       I AFTER_SAVE                    Method After Which Data Was Saved                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EXTEND       I BEFORE_CHANGE                 Method Before Data (e.g. Order) Is Changed                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EXTEND       I BEFORE_DIALOG                 Method Before Dialog Is Constructed                         .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_EXTEND       I BEFORE_SAVE                   Method Before Changed Data Is Saved                         .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_IM_EVSTA     I CHANGE_STATUS                 Change Status of Medication                                 .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_MOSTATUS     I BEFORE_DIALOG                 BAdI for Presetting/Deactivating Dialog                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_MOSTATUS     I CHECK_IF_CHANGE_POSSIBLE      Check Whether Status Change Is Possible                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_MOSTATUS     I EXIT_AFTER_SAVE               Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_MOSTATUS     I EXIT_BEFORE_CHANGE            Edit Data Before Change                                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_MOSTATUS     I EXIT_BEFORE_SAVE              Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_SUSPORD      I EVENTS_TO_CANCEL              Specify Which EVents Should Be Canceled                     .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_SUSPORD      I EXIT_AFTER_SAVE               Edit Data After Save                                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_SUSPORD      I EXIT_BEFORE_SAVE              Edit Data Before Save                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHANGE_SUSPORD      I EXIT_BEFORE_SUSPEND           Edit Data Before Deactivation                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_CHDVER_DETERMIN     I DETERMINE_CHDVER              Determine the Field N1MEORDER-CHDVER                        .
IF_EX_N1ME_COMMIT_WORK         I AFTER_COMMIT                  Execute Actions AFTER COMMIT WORK                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_COMMIT_WORK         I BEFORE_COMMIT                 Execute Actions BEFORE COMMIT WORK                          .
IF_EX_N1ME_COPY_ORDER          I SET_DEFAULTS_POPUP            Preset Dialog Box for Copying Order                         .
IF_EX_N1ME_CUST_ORD_HEADER     I CREATE                        Create and Initialize Screen Class of Subscreen             .
IF_EX_N1ME_DATAS               I CREATE                        Create Instance of Data Class                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_DATAS               I LOAD                          Load Instance of Data Class                                 .
IF_EX_N1ME_DRUG_SEL_CHECK      I CHECK_AFTER_DRUGSEL           Checks After Drug Selection or Change                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_DYNAM_SUBSCR        I CREATE                        Create and Initialize Screen Classes of Tab Strip           .
IF_EX_N1ME_EVENT_GENERATE      I GENERATE_EVENTS               Create Drug Events                                          .
IF_EX_N1ME_EVENT_POST_COND     I SET_CONDITION                 Method for Determining Goods Issue Posting                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_F4_HELP             I VALUE_REQUEST                 Call F4 Help                                                .
IF_EX_N1ME_GET_CASE            I EXIT_GET_CASE                 Determine Case Number for Order                             .
IF_EX_N1ME_GET_HEIGHT          I EXIT_GET_HEIGHT               Change Height                                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_GET_OBJ_FOR_OBJ     I GET_OBJECT_FOR_OBJ            Determine Object for Other Object                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_GET_VMA             I GET_VMA                       Determine EmR                                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_GET_WEIGHT          I EXIT_GET_WEIGHT               Change Weight                                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_NEWRVER_DETERMI     I DETERMINE_NEWRVER             Specify Field N1ORATE-NEWRVER                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I CHECK                         Check Data                                                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I CHECK_FOR_CHANGES             Has data changed?                                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I COPY_ORDER                    Call in "Copy Order" Function                               .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I CREATE                        Constructing Control Logic                                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I DESTROY                       Exiting Dialog                                              .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I END_PROGRAM                   Execute Actions when Ending Order Framework                 .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I PAI_CHANGE_DATA               Execute Data Changes After PAI (Before OK Code)             .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SET_DEFAULTS                  Make/Change Data Presettings                                .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SET_DEFAULTS_ENTRY_SCR        Preset Initial Screen                                       .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SET_DEFAULTS_TMPL             Execute Presettings For Templates                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SET_GUI_STATUS                Set or Override GUI Status and Title Bar                    .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I SET_TMPL_FROM_ORDER           Defaults if Template Is Created from Order                  .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_DIALOG        I USER_COMMAND                  Before Standard User Command Processing Call                .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_ENTRY         I ENTER_FRAMEWORK_CHECKS        Access to Order Framework                                   .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_HARDSTOP      I CALCULATE_HARDSTOP            Calculate Maximum Order Duration                            .
IF_EX_N1ME_ORDER_HARDSTOP      I SET_END_DATE                  Set/Change Duration and/or End Time of Order                .
IF_EX_N1ME_PREVENT             I CHANGE_PREVENT                Change Predefined Events                                    .
IF_EX_N1ME_READ_PARAM          I READ_PARAMETER                Export Parameters                                           .
IF_EX_N1ME_WP_012              I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Customer-Specific Data Display in Med. Orders View          .
IF_EX_N1ME_WP_012              I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Customer-Specifc Function Execution - Medication Orders     .
IF_EX_N1ME_WP_013              I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Cust-Specif. Data Disp. Events/Inpat Nursing Svce View Type .
IF_EX_N1ME_WP_013              I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Cust.-Specifc Functions Events/Inpat. Nurs. Svce View Type  .
IF_EX_N1PACSSTRUCTURE          I CONVERSION                    Covert Structure                                            .
IF_EX_N1PATORG_APPEND          I EXECUTE_APPEND                Append Structure Function                                   .
IF_EX_N1PATORG_APPEND          I FILL_SORT                     Fill Append Structure and Sort Data Records                 .
IF_EX_N1PATORG_APPEND          I SELECT                        Select Data                                                 .
IF_EX_N1REQUESTNUMBERCHECK     I EXIT_REQEST_NUMBER_CHECK      Customized Checks for the REQNO + Modification Option       .
IF_EX_N1VKPRINT                I EXIT_PRINT                    Print of Pre-registration List                              .
IF_EX_N1_APPOINTMENT           I CASEFORFOLLOWUP               Override the Default Action for the Follow-Up List          .
IF_EX_N1_APPS_MOVE             I PREALLOCATE                   Presetting of Parameter for Collective Processing           .
IF_EX_N1_CANCEL                I EXIT_CANCEL_CHECK             IS-H*MED: Customer-Specific Cancellation Checks             .
IF_EX_N1_CANCEL                I EXIT_CANCEL_COLLECT           IS-H*MED: Collect Customer-Specific Cancellation Data       .
IF_EX_N1_CANCEL                I EXIT_CANCEL_SAVE              IS-H*MED: Also Update Customer-Specific Cancellation Data   .
IF_EX_N1_CHG_APP_TEMPLATE      I CHG_APP_TEMPLATE              Change Template for an Appointment                          .
IF_EX_N1_CONNECTIVITY          I EXIT_CHECK                    Check Data                                                  .
IF_EX_N1_CONNECTIVITY          I EXIT_EXPORT                   Export Data                                                 .
IF_EX_N1_CONNECTIVITY          I EXIT_IMPORT_CORDER            Import Data for Clinical Orders                             .
IF_EX_N1_CONTEXT_DIALOG        I CHANGE_DOC_CLASSIFICATION     Change Display of Document Classification                   .
IF_EX_N1_CORDER_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check Clinical Order                                        .
IF_EX_N1_CORDER_PREALLOC       I PREALLOC                      Preset Clinical Order                                       .
IF_EX_N1_CORDER_PRINT_SSF      I MODIFY_DATA                   Modification of Data Interface                              .
IF_EX_N1_CORDER_USER_COMM      I BEFORE_UCOMM                  Clinical Order: Call BEFORE User Command Executed           .
IF_EX_N1_CREATE_COMPCON        I CREATE_COMPCON                Creates an IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG Object                   .
IF_EX_N1_CREATE_COMPONENT      I CREATE_COMPONENT_BASE         Creates an IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE Object                     .
IF_EX_N1_CREATE_CONFIG         I CREATE_CONFIG                 Creates an IF_ISH_CONFIG Object                             .
IF_EX_N1_CREATE_PRC_POPUP      I CREATE_PRC_POPUP              Creates an IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP Object                          .
IF_EX_N1_CREATE_SCREEN         I CREATE_SCREEN                 Instantiation of a Screen Object                            .
IF_EX_N1_DOC_PREPARE_ADDR      I PREPARE_ADDRESS               Customer-Specific Recipient Presetting/Postsetting          .
IF_EX_N1_DOC_PREPARE_PRINT     I PREPARE_PRINTER               Override Printer Presetting for Document Dispatch           .
IF_EX_N1_FA_CALCULATE          I EXIT_FA_CALCULATE             Calculate Duration of a Transport Order                     .
IF_EX_N1_FCT_TEAM_SAVE         I EXIT_TEAM_SAVE                Change Team Before Saving Team Entry                        .
IF_EX_N1_GENERATE_MEEVENT      I GENERATE_MEEVENT              Change Event Table on Generation                            .
IF_EX_N1_HLST_NEW_FIELDS       I EXIT_NEW_FIELDS               Hit List: New Columns                                       .
IF_EX_N1_INTERNET_SERVICE      I APPOINTMENT_SRCH_CRITERIA     Change Criteria for Appointment Search                      .
IF_EX_N1_MEDSRV_INFO           I BUILD_DD_DOCUMENT             Method to Create Dynamic Document for Info Screen           .
IF_EX_N1_MEEVENT               I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Event Generation Change                                     .
IF_EX_N1_NBEW_SAVE             I EXIT_NBEW_SAVE                Pre-set Movement when Saving                                .
IF_EX_N1_OP_PROGRAMM           I EXIT_OP_TIMER_DESTROY         Dismantle Surgery Timer for the Automatic Updating          .
IF_EX_N1_OP_PROGRAMM           I EXIT_OP_TIMER_INITIALIZE      Initialize Surgery Timer for the Automatic Updating         .
IF_EX_N1_OP_PROGRAMM           I EXIT_OP_TIMER_START           Start Surgery Timer for the Automatic Updating              .
IF_EX_N1_OP_PROGRAMM           I EXIT_OP_TIMER_STOP            Stop Surgery Timer for the Automatic Updating               .
IF_EX_N1_PERFORM_SERVICE       I EXIT_PERFORM_SERVICE          Prohibit Performing/Releasing of Services                   .
IF_EX_N1_PERFORM_SRV_CHECK     I EXIT_PERFORM_CHECK            IS-H*MED: Perform/Release: Additional Checks                .
IF_EX_N1_PERFORM_SRV_SAVE      I EXIT_PERFORM_SAVE             IS-H*MED: Call During Update (Before COMMIT WORK!)          .
IF_EX_N1_PG_GET_START_POS      I GET_START_POS                 Determine Start Positions in Planning Grid                  .
IF_EX_N1_PG_LABEL_APP          I LABELAPP                      Labelling of Appointments in Planning Grid                  .
IF_EX_N1_PG_LABEL_TIMEGRID     I LABEL_TIMEGRID                Labelling of Time Grid in Planning Grid                     .
IF_EX_N1_PG_LABEL_TIMESLOT     I LABEL_TIMESLOT                Labelling of Time Slot                                      .
IF_EX_N1_PREPARE_ADMISSION     I PREPARE_ADMISSION             Change Default of the Admission Transactions                .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check Preregistration                                       .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_PREALLOC       I PREALLOC                      Preset Preregistration                                      .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I BEFORE_PBO                    Call Before Every Subscreen PBO Run (PBO)                   .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I CHECK_DATA                    Perform Subscreen Check (PAI)                               .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I CHECK_FOR_CHANGES             Check Whether Subscreen Data Is Changed (PAI)               .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I GET_DATA                      Get Data (OK Code and so on) from Subscreen (PAI)           .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I INITIALIZE                    Determine Subscreen Name (PgmName, DYNNR) (PBO)             .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I SAVE                          Update Subscreen Data Also (PAI)                            .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I SET_CURSOR                    Position Cursor on Field in Subscreen (PAI)                 .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_SUBSCREEN      I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data (OK Code and so on) to Subscreen (PAI)        .
IF_EX_N1_PREREG_USER_COMM      I BEFORE_UCOMM                  Preregistration: Call BEFORE Executing the User Command     .
IF_EX_N1_PTS_FPV               I EXIT_GET_FPV                  Determine the Available Transporters                        .
IF_EX_N1_SCR_PARTNER           I EXIT_CHANGE                   Restrict Employee Selection                                 .
IF_EX_N1_SET_PLAN_TOOL         I SET_PLAN_TOOL                 Sets Planning Tool to Be Used (Planning Grid, Appt Editor)  .
IF_EX_N1_VITPAR_DIALOG         I EXIT_CHECK                    Additional Vital Sign Check                                 .
IF_EX_N1_VITPAR_DIALOG         I EXIT_VORBEL                   Change Dialog Box Defaults                                  .
IF_EX_N1_WPOOL_LABEL_NODE      I LABEL_NODE                    Planning Tool, Worklist: Label Nodes                        .
IF_EX_N1_WP_LSTAMB             I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Clin. Work Station Overrides Fields of View Type OutpC/SvceF.
IF_EX_N1_WP_LSTAMB             I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Clin. Work Stat. Overrides FCODES View Type OutpC/Svce Fclty.
IF_EX_N1_WP_OP                 I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Customer-Specific Data Display in Surgery Views             .
IF_EX_N1_WP_OP                 I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Customer-Specific Function Execution in Surgery Views       .
IF_EX_N1_WP_OP                 I EXIT_PRINT                    Customer-Specific Print in Surgery Views                    .
IF_EX_N1_WP_PTS                I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Clin. Work Stat. Overrides Fields of Transp Orders View Type.
IF_EX_N1_WP_PTS                I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Clin. Work Stat. Overrides FCODEs of Transp Orders View Type.
IF_EX_N1_WP_REQUEST            I EXIT_DISPLAY                  CWS Overrides Fields of "Clinical Orders" View Type         .
IF_EX_N1_WP_REQUEST            I EXIT_FUNCTION                 CWS Overrides FCODEs of "Clinical Orders" View Type         .
IF_EX_N2M_ASSO_OTF_FROM_TC     I GET_DATA_FROM_COMPLETE_TAB    Data Transfer From Associated Items                         .
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_ASSO_DATA     I CHANGE_ASSO_DATA_OTF          Change Association Partner on the Fly                       .
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_ASSO_DATA     I CHANGE_ASSO_DATA_REASSO       Change Assocation Partner Before Calling Reassoc. Dialog Box.
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_ASSO_DATA     I MARK_DATA_AS_CROSS_REFERENCED Identify Association Partner For Association                .
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_ASSO_DATA     I RESET                         Reset Internally Used Structures                            .
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_ASSO_DATA     I SET_VALUE                     Set a Value on the Screen                                   .
IF_EX_N2M_CHANGE_LEAD_TAB      I CHANGE                        Cahnge the table of leading document items                  .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_ASSO_DATA      I CHECK_ASSOCIATED_DATA         Check Associated Items on the Fly                           .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_ASSO_DATA      I CHECK_ASSOCIATED_DATA_ALL     Check Associated Items on the Fly                           .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_ASSO_DATA      I CHECK_CROSS_REFERENCED_DATA   Check Cross-Referenced Items                                .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_ASSO_IN_TC     I CHECK_INCREASED_QUAN_AUTO_ASSOChecks Automat. Adjustment of Assoc. in Case of Greater Qty .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_ASSO_IN_TC     I DELETE_AUTO_ADJUST            Deletes the ID for Automatic Adjustment of the Assoc.       .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_REL_SHIP       I CHECK_AFTER_QUAN_CHANGE       Check the associations after the quantity was changed       .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_REL_SHIP       I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Check the associations before update                        .
IF_EX_N2M_CHECK_TC             I STATUS                        Is the trading contract suitable for Association Management?.
IF_EX_N2M_FAILED_UNLINK        I IS_STOPPED                    Continue After Association Separation Failed?               .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_PARTNER     I CHANGE_LEADER_DATA            Change Data of Leading Item                                 .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_PARTNER     I CHECK_ERROR_TEW_CANDIDATE     Review Association Candidates                               .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_PARTNER     I CHECK_ERROR_TEW_PARTNER       Review of Association Partner                               .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_PARTNER     I FILTER                        Filter Association Partners                                 .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_TABS        I FILTER                        Filter Association Partners                                 .
IF_EX_N2M_FLT_ASSO_TABS        I FILTER_CANDIDATES             Filter Out Certain Document Types As Candidates             .
IF_EX_N2M_QUANTITY_DISTRIB     I DISTRIBUTION                  User-Defined Reassociation                                  .
IF_EX_N2M_QUANTITY_DISTRIB     I DO_FULLY_INCREASE             Increase Associations Parallel with Item Quantity           .
IF_EX_N2M_QUANTITY_DISTRIB     I IS_FULL_ASSOCIATED            Is Item Fully Associated?                                   .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_DLE_ATTR               Change defect log entry attributes "OBSOLETE                .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_EQL_ATTR               Change Equipment logbook attributes                         .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Change the fields that are displayed "OBSOLETE              .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_FLE_ATTR               Change flight log entry attributes "OBSOLETE                .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_FLL_ATTR               Change Functional location logbook attributes               .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_LGE_ATTR               Change log entry attributes "OBSOLETE                       .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_LGN_ATTR               Change Log notification attributes                          .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_MDC_ATTR               Change measurement document attributes                      .
IF_EX_NAVIGATION_ACL           I CHANGE_NTF_ATTR               Change Notification attributes                              .
IF_EX_NETW_DIR_PROCUREMENT     I GET_DATA                      User-Defined Checks for Materials Without Material Numbers  .
IF_EX_NETW_POSI_CONFI_LIST     I AT_POSI                       Position                                                    .
IF_EX_NETW_USER_FIELDS_F4      I AT_F4                         F4 Help for User Field                                      .
IF_EX_NOTIF_ACTIONBOX          I SELECT_FUNCTION               Hide a Function in the Action Box                           .
IF_EX_NOTIF_AUTHORITY_01       I CHECK_LOCATION_TAB            Check Activity Type for Change to Location Data             .
IF_EX_NOTIF_COST_CHECK_WBS     I CHECK_WBS                     WBS Element Check                                           .
IF_EX_NOTIF_COST_COLLECTOR     I CREATE_CHANGE                 Create and Change Cost Collector for Notification           .
IF_EX_NOTIF_COST_CUS_CHECK     I CHECK                         Check Whether Cost Collector Should Be Created              .
IF_EX_NOTIF_COST_SET_STAT      I SET_COST_COLLECTOR_STAT       Setting of Status of Cost Collector                         .
IF_EX_NOTIF_CREATE_OBJ         I GET_DATA_SERIALNO             Returns Data Related to Creation of a Serial Number         .
IF_EX_NOTIF_EVENT_POST         I CHECK_DATA_AT_POST            Notification Data - Before and After Image                  .
IF_EX_NOTIF_EVENT_SAVE         I CHANGE_DATA_AT_SAVE           Change of Notification Data Depending on Notification Type  .
IF_EX_NOTIF_FORM_PARAM         I GET_FORM_PARAMETERS           Get the smart form interface parameters                     .
IF_EX_NOTIF_LINK_MAINT         I MAINTAIN_LINK_TABLE           Maintains Link table entry in special case (eg . No Archive).
IF_EX_N_ALT_APP_SEARCH_DYN     I ALT_APP_SEARCH_SCREEN         Time Slot Search:Alternative Input Screen for Search Variant.
IF_EX_N_APP_CONSTR_CHG         I CHG_APP_CONSTR                Change an Appointment Template                              .
IF_EX_N_WP_MEDCONTROL          I EXIT_DISPLAY                  Clin. Work Station Override Fields View Type Coding Analyses.
IF_EX_N_WP_MEDCONTROL          I EXIT_FUNCTION                 Clin.Work Station Override FCODEs View Type Coding Analyses .
IF_EX_OFFLINE_APPL             I INBOUND                       Inbound Processing - Before Calling BAPI/Function Module    .
IF_EX_OFFLINE_APPL             I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Processing - After Calling BAPI/Function Module    .
IF_EX_OFX_ACCOUNT_STMT         I ACC_STMT_REQUEST_CHANGE       Change OFX request for account statement request            .
IF_EX_OFX_ACCOUNT_STMT         I ACC_STMT_RESPONSE_CHANGE      Change OFX response for account statement                   .
IF_EX_OFX_PAYMENT              I ACC_OFX_PAYMENT_RS_CHANGE     Changing of the OFX Response for the Payment                .
IF_EX_OI0_BADI_OGSD_SCD        I SHIPMENT_F4_EXTENDED          Extended F4-help for shipment numbers                       .
IF_EX_OI0_BADI_OGSD_SCD        I SHIPMENT_READ                 Read transport for Shipment Costs Document                  .
IF_EX_OI0_MM_CONTRACT          I MANIPULATE_BTC_TABLE          Manipulate BTC Table (add customer spec. fields)            .
IF_EX_OI0_MM_CONTRACT          I MANIPULATE_INTERFACE_DATA     Manipulate interface data                                   .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_DOC_FLOW        I PREDECESSOR_EDIT              Create or change predecessor entries in VBFA                .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_DOC_FLOW        I PREDECESSOR_ITEM_SELECT       Fill KOMPO depending on VBAP, VBRP, LIPS, or OGSD own struct.
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_OII_DOC_IF      I UPDATE_DEL_NOTE_VIEW          OIL-BDRP: Update delivery note view for goods issue         .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_OUTPUT_COM      I KOMKBV1_FILL                  Add. fields into the communication table for appl. V1       .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_OUTPUT_COM      I KOMKBV1_FILL_PARTNER          Add. partner into the communication table for appl. V1      .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_TAS_DATA        I SAVE_LID_REFERENCE_DATA       User exit save LID-reference data and document item data    .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I CUSTOMER_DATA_READ            Read Customer-Specific Data when Importing PO document      .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I CUSTSCR1_HEAD_SET_DATA_PBO    Export Data to Customer Subscreen for PO-doc. Header (PBO)  .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I CUSTSCR1_ITEM_GET_DATA_PAI    Import Data from Customer Subscreen for PO-doc. Item (PAI)  .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I CUSTSCR1_ITEM_SET_DATA_PAI    Export Data to Customer Subscreen for PO-doc. Item (PAI)    .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I CUSTSCR1_ITEM_SET_DATA_PBO    Export Data to Customer Subscreen for PO-doc. Item (PBO)    .
IF_EX_OI0_OGSD_XM06            I ME_FILL_KOMP                  Extend Communication Structure KOMP for Pricing             .
IF_EX_OI0_OP_PROC              I PROCESS_CP_OPERATORS          Process Compatible Operaotors                               .
IF_EX_OIA_DEL_COST_REPRICE     I SET_IV_PRICING_PARAMETER      Derive user defined pricing parameters at IV                .
IF_EX_OIA_ERS_ENHANCEMENT      I ON_INVOICE_SPLIT              New invoice after XXX items                                 .
IF_EX_OIA_EXGAGRMNT            I CREATE_POSTPROCESSING         Outbound processing of Exchange Agreement data              .
IF_EX_OIA_EXGAGRMNT            I CREATE_PREPROCESSING          Inbound processing of Exchange Agreement data               .
IF_EX_OIA_EXGAGRMNT_VALID      I ON_HEADER_CHANGE              Agreement header data has been changed                      .
IF_EX_OIA_EXGAGRMNT_VALID      I ON_ITEM_CHANGE                Agreement item data (contracts) has been changed            .
IF_EX_OIA_LIA_POSTZERO         I ON_POSTZERO                   Value is zero                                               .
IF_EX_OIA_LIA_POST_ZERO        I ON_POSTZERO                   Value is zero                                               .
IF_EX_OIA_QS_ENHANCEMENT       I ON_QS_PBO                     Quantity schedule handling before output on the screen      .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_CUST_PARAM       I MOVE_CUST_PAR_TO_RESULT       Move customer own results to SAP structure                  .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_DET_DEF          I CHANGE_DEFAULT_DET_DATA       Customers can change input data of function module          .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_DET_DEF          I DETERMINE_DEFAULT_DATA        Customer method to determine default data                   .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_DIM1_TO_DIM2     I AIR_BOUYANCY_OVERWRITE        Overwrite standard SAP air buoyancy adjustment              .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_DIM1_TO_DIM2     I DIMENSION_TO_DIMENSION        Conversion of a quantity with unit1(dim1) to unit2(dim2)    .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_EXTERNALFUNC     I CALL_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION1       Method1 to implement customer specific conversion routines  .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_EXTERNALFUNC     I CALL_CUSTOMER_FUNCTION2       Method2 to implement customer specific conversion routines  .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_EXTERNALFUNC     I MOD_C_CODE_PARAMETER_A        Method to modify c-code parameters after calling the c-code .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_EXTERNALFUNC     I MOD_C_CODE_PARAMETER_B        Method to modify c-code parameters before calling the c-code.
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I CALC_BASE_DENSITY             Calculate  natural gas base base density                    .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I CALC_BASE_HEATINGVALUE        Calculate natural gas base heating value                    .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I CALC_IDEAL_GAS_VCF            Calculate ideal gas volume correction factor                .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I CORR_COMBUSTION_ENERGY        Correct energy to different combustion temperature          .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I DENSITY_HVALUE_CONVERT        Convert base density and base heating value to SI units     .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I DETERMINE_AIR_COMP_FAC        Determine dry air compression factor                        .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_NATURAL_GAS      I DETERMINE_Z_FACTOR            Determine nat.gas compression factor from AGA c-code results.
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_RAWMATERIALS     I MODIFY_RAWMAT_CONVERSION      Exit to modify standard mat. conversion using customer par. .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_ROUND_QTY        I CHECK_QCI_INPUT               Check Input Data Tables of QCI                              .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_ROUND_QTY        I CHECK_TOLERANCE               Check tolerance level and checks of manual entry            .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_ROUND_QTY        I ROUND_AROMATICS_PARAM         Round Parameters for Aromatics VCF Determination            .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_ROUND_QTY        I ROUND_INTERMEDIATE            Round Intermediate Results Between Different Dimensions     .
IF_EX_OIB_QCI_ROUND_QTY        I ROUND_QTY                     Rounding Quantities                                         .
IF_EX_OIC_CPE_FILL_ATTRIB      I FILL_ATTRIBUTES               Fill Customer Attributes                                    .
IF_EX_OIC_GET_LSMW_INFO        I GET_LSMW_INFO                 Get LSMW Information                                        .
IF_EX_OIC_GR_REPRICE_CHECK     I PROCESS_MOVEMENT_CHECK        Check if material movements require repricing               .
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_ITEM        I CHANGE_CALCULATION_TYPE       Change Re-pricing Type for External Details Change          .
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_ITEM        I CHECK_ITEM_FOR_DELET          Add. examination can be entered, before item is rel. to del..
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_ITEM        I FILL_VBEP                     Move some fields into the sales dokument schedule line WA   .
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_ITEM        I NEW_PRICING_VBAP              Perform new pricing, dependant on the change of datafields  .
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_ITEM        I SOURCE_DETERMINATION          Add. logic for det. the source of the plant or the item cat..
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_SSCFLOW     I PAI_SAPLV45C_0100             BADI in PAI of Container Screen for Creating Orders with Ref.
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_SSCFLOW     I PBO_SAPLV45C_0100             BADI in PBO of Container Screen for Creating Orders with Ref.
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_SSCFLOW     I PROCESS_FINAL_PAI             BADI for the end of PAI processing                          .
IF_EX_OID_SD_SALES_SSCFLOW     I PROCESS_FINAL_PBO             BADI for the end of PBO processing                          .
IF_EX_OIG_DG_DATA_MAINTAIN     I DATA_STORE                    Store the vehicle data for the customer                     .
IF_EX_OIG_MAT_DOC_CHANGE       I CHANGE_MM_DATA                Modify goods movement posting.                              .
IF_EX_OIH_ADD_LICENSE_DATA     I ADD_LICENSE_DATA              Adding License data to material item                        .
IF_EX_OIH_CHECK_LICENSE        I IF_EX_OIH_CHECK_LICENSE       Check License                                               .
IF_EX_OIH_DEF_HT_MB            I DEFAULT_HT                    Defaulting of Handling Type                                 .
IF_EX_OIH_ED_VAL_DEF           I DETERMINE_HANTYP_BWTAR        Handling type defaulting and validation                     .
IF_EX_OIIM_USER_SCREEN         I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get data from screen                                        .
IF_EX_OIIM_USER_SCREEN         I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Put data to screen                                          .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ADD_COLUMNS      I SET_COLUMN_NAMES              set customer column names                                   .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ADD_COLUMNS      I SET_CUST_FIELDS               fill customer fields                                        .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ADD_COLUMNS      I SET_LOCAL_TIME_DATE           set local time/date                                         .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I CREATE_MM_DATA                Additional analysis functions for MM analysis               .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I EXTEND_FIELDCAT               Add customer defined fields to Analysis detail display      .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I HANDLE_TOOLBAR                Add or remove user commands from analysis detail            .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           Handle customer defined user commands                       .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I PREPARE_MM_DISPLAY            Data Preparation for analysis display                       .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_ANALYSIS         I SAVE_STOCKS_SEPARATED         Tank Dip: Save book stock level of individual stock segments.
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I ADDITIONAL_CALCULATION        Additional calculations for tank dips                       .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I ADDITIONAL_CHECKS             Additional checks during change/deletion of tank dips       .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I FLOATING_ROOF_AIRBUOYANCY_FACTAir boyancy factor for floating roof correction             .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I FLOATING_ROOF_CORRECTION      Special calculation for floating roof correction            .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I MODIFY_CALCULATION            Modify the tank dip calculation in OII_TANK_DIP_CALCULATOR  .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_CALCULATION      I PREPARE_PARAMETERS            Additional calculations for tank dips                       .
IF_EX_OII_DIP_EXTERNAL         I UPLOAD_PREPROCESSING          Control input parameters, inbound modifications             .
IF_EX_OII_TANK_MM_HANDLING     I ADDITIONAL_MM_CHECKS          Additional_MM_checks                                        .
IF_EX_OIJP_SFT_CALC_CUST       I SFT_CALC_TMDEP_CUST_01        Calculate  time dependent safety  stock                     .
IF_EX_OIJP_TGT_CALC_CUST       I TGT_CALC_CUST_01              Calculate target stock                                      .
IF_EX_OIJP_TGT_CALC_CUST       I TGT_CALC_TMDEP_CUST_01        Calculate  time dependent target stock                      .
IF_EX_OIJU_PHYINV              I CHANGE_PHYINV_DISPLAY         Change physical inventory for display                       .
IF_EX_OIJU_PHYINV              I UPDATE_PREPROCESSING          Customer specific processing                                .
IF_EX_OIJU_PHYINV              I VALIDATE_INPUT                Validate Initial Screen inputs                              .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_AGGREGATE_RACK_DATA        BADI to overwrite SAP rack forecasts aggregation logic      .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_AVG_POPUP                  BADI to handle the average consumption pop-up               .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_CALC_CUST                  Overwrite SAP TSW standard rundown logic                    .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_CALC_PERIOD_CUST           Calculate stock projection period for different Sp types    .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_CUST_FCTYPE_SETTING        BADI to fetch rack forceast settings for customer types     .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_EXPAND_MULTIPLE            BADI to modify the expanding of multiple SP entries         .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_GRID_HEADING               BADI to overwrite SPW ALV grid heading                      .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_LINECALC_CUST              BADI to overwrite SAP TSW standard rundown logic on date lev.
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_NOMINATION_OIJRDNOM        Overwrite OIJRDNOM data in rundown output nomination selecti.
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_NOMINATION_SELECT          Overwrite  the nomination selection in the rundown update   .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_NOMINATION_SELECT_TS       Overwrite the nom. selection in the rundown update / TS     .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_OPEN_INV                   Overwrite the book / physical inventory                     .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_OUTPUT                     BADI to fill rundown output table for display in ALV grid   .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_OUTPUT_MOD                 BADI to fill rundown output table for display in ALV grid   .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_REALTIME_SELECT            Overwrite selection of real-time rundown                    .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_RESTORE_HEEL               Restore heel in rundown                                     .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_RVP_CALC                   Overwrite the RVP calculation                               .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_SUBTRACT_HEEL              Subtract heel in rundown                                    .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_TICKET_SELECT              Overwrite the ticket selection in the rundown update        .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_TICKET_SELECT_TS           Overwrite the ticket selection in the rundown update / TS   .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_UNACC_NEGATIVE             BADI to switch off accumulation of  negatives               .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_UNACTUAL_QTY               Overwrite the unactualised quantity                         .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_UNCOMM                     BADI to calculate the uncommitted value                     .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_UPDATE_CUST                BADI to update customer fields in SP header / table         .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_CALC_CUST        I RD_WHIF_CALC                  BADI to overwrite the SAP TSW rundown what-if calculation   .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_FC_CUST          I RD_FC_CUST_01                 Generate rack issue forecast                                .
IF_EX_OIJU_RD_TICKET           I RD_TICKET_END_DATE            BADI to manipulate Ticket End date for SP                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_3WP_SEL_SCREEN       I DEFAULT                       Default data to Selection Screen                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_3WP_TEXT             I TEXT_UPDATE                   3WP Text Update in ALV Outtab                               .
IF_EX_OIJ_3WP_UI               I DS_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY          set the properties of the fields in the DS output table     .
IF_EX_OIJ_3WP_UI               I DS_ALV_REFRESH_DISPLAY        refresh the properties of the fields in the DS output table .
IF_EX_OIJ_AMMEND_3WP_FIELD     I AMMEND_3WP_FIELDS             Ammend 3WP fields to tables demand, supply, TA, DS          .
IF_EX_OIJ_APOFCST_MAINTAIN     I MAINTAIN                      APO DP Forecast maintenance in TSW SPW                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I AFTER_CONTROLS_INIT           Setting Up Reference to UI Controls and Data Class          .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I EVT_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY         Influencing Nom. Event ALV Before Displayed for First Time  .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I EVT_ALV_HANDLE_BUTTON         Handling button of Nomination Event ALV                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I EVT_ALV_HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU   Handling Context Menu of Nomination Event ALV               .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I EVT_ALV_HANDLE_FCODE          Handling Function Code of Nomination Event ALV              .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I EVT_ALV_HANDLE_TOOLBAR        Handling Toolbar of Nomination Event ALV                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I ITM_TB_ADD_BUTTONS            Adding Buttons to Application Toolbar                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I ITM_TB_DROPDOWN_CLICKED       Handling Dropdown Menu in Application Toolbar               .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I ITM_TB_FUNCTION_SELECTED      Handling Function Selected in Application Toolbar           .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY         Influencing ALV of Load/Disch. Data Before Displ. First Time.
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_ALV_HANDLE_BUTTON         Handling Button of ALV for Load/Discharge Data              .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_ALV_HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU   Handling Context Menu of ALV for Load/Discharge Data        .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_ALV_HANDLE_FCODE          Handling Function Code of ALV for Load/Discharge Data       .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_ALV_HANDLE_TOOLBAR        Handling Toolbar of ALV for Load/Discharge Data             .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_CHART_BEFORE_PBO          Changing All Data that Goes to the Bar Chart Control        .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LDS_CHART_LAYER_DESCRIPTION   Modifying the Tooltip of a Layer Displayed in the Bar Chart .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LYT_TREE_FIRST_DISPLAY        Influencing Laytime Tree Before it Is Displayed             .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I LYT_TREE_HANDLE_CONTEXT_REQ   Handling Context Request of Laytime Tree                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I SEL_TREE_FIRST_DISPLAY        Influencing Selection Tree Before it Is Displayed           .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_GUI              I SEL_TREE_HANDLE_CONTEXT_REQ   Handling Context Request of Selection Tree                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I AT_STARTUP                    Determining Screen Called in Berth Planning Board           .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I CALL_SELECTION_SCREEN         Calling Selection Screen Again (Called by Selection Tree)   .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I HANDLE_PAI                    Handling the PAI Event of the Current Screen                .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I HANDLE_PBO                    Handling the PBO Event of the Current Screen                .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I INITIALIZE_CONTROLS           Creating All UI Controls Used and Defining their Order      .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I SET_STATUS                    Excluding GUI Function of Screen 0100                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I START_OF_SELECTION            Determining How Selection Is Executed                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_MAIN             I VALIDATE_LDS_CHANGE           Validating the Changed Load/Discharge Data                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_BPB_OPT              I OPTIMIZE                      Optimize the Data Used in Berth Planning Board              .
IF_EX_OIJ_CALC_DEM             I CALC_DEMURRAGE                Calculate despatch and demurrage                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_CALC_LOC_DURTION     I CALC_DURATION                 Calculate Duration between two TSW-Locations                .
IF_EX_OIJ_DEF_BERTH_SELECT     I GET_BERTH                     picks a berth from list of suitable berths                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_DET_DATE             I FIND_DATE                     Find date method                                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_EVM_NOM_PROC      I PROCESS_NOMINATION            Process Nomination                                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_MVSCEN            I GET_SCENARIO_DETAIL           Overwrite the standard movement scenario                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_PRORATE           I CALCULATE                     Method to calculate prorate quantities                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_TERMS_CHECK       I CHECK_LAYT_TERMS              Laytime terms check method                                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS       I M_03                          TSW Details customer function                               .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS       I OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS_01         PBO TSW Details customer function                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS       I OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS_02         PAI TSW Details customer function                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS       I OIJ_EL_TSW_DETAILS_03         TSW Details - Before calling TSW details and before saving  .
IF_EX_OIJ_EXIT_TKT_PROCESS     I EXIT_TKT_ARCH                 exits archiving a ticket                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_EXT_DET              I EXT_DETAILS_PROCESSING        Handling of extern. Details Processing for MM/SD Documents  .
IF_EX_OIJ_IF                   I CREATE_NOMREF_PREPROCESSING   Create TSW Nomination with reference Preprocessing          .
IF_EX_OIJ_IF                   I CREATE_NOM_POSTPROCESSING     Create TSW Nomination Postprocessing                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_IF                   I CREATE_NOM_PREPROCESSING      Create TSW Nomination Preprocessing                         .
IF_EX_OIJ_IF                   I CREATE_PART_POSTPROCESSING    Create TSW Partner Role Postprocessing                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_IF                   I CREATE_PART_PREPROCESSING     Create TSW Partner Role Preprocessing                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB                   I TRANSFER_ALL_IAR              Transfer All Logic for inventory Adjustment requests        .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB                   I TRANSFER_ALL_IBID             Transfer All Logic for inventory Builds and draws           .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_CHECK_DMD_SUP     I CHECK_FOR_DEMAND_SUPPLY       Check for demand supply                                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_INV               I SCHED_IN_INV_IMBAL_CALC       Check Sched entry usage Inventory and Imbalance Calculation .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_PAST_INV          I OIJ_RD_INV_ENTRIES            populate past days inventory on scheduled date.             .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_USER_FIELDS       I ADD_COL_HDRDETAILS            Add user fields to GT_HDR_OUTTAB                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_USER_FIELDS       I ADD_COL_ITEMDETAILS           Add user fields to GT_ITEM_OUTTAB                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_LB_VALIDATE          I VALIDATE_SCHED_ENTRIES        Method for additional validations in LB                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_LT_ACCOUNTING        I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get data from screen                                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_LT_ACCOUNTING        I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Put data to screen                                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_LT_ACT               I CALC_LAYTIME                  Calculate actual laytime                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_MD                   I OIJ_PART_SAVE_PREP            BADI to prepare partner role save                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_METER_RECONCILE      I ADJUST_TD_RACK_METER          Adjust TD rack meter corresponding to a meter at TSW locatn .
IF_EX_OIJ_METER_RECONCILE      I ADJUST_TSW_METER              Adjust TSW meter corresponding to a TD rack meter           .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM                  I EXT_DETAILS_PROCESSING        Handling of extern. Details Processing for MM/SD Documents  .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM                  I FCODE_UPDATE_PROCESSING       Nomination save processing Exit                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM                  I HEADER_PREPROCESSING          Nomination header preprocessing add in                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMEV_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      Item validation method                                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMHD_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      Header validation method                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMIT_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      Item validation method                                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMLD_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      LD Scheduling Validation Method                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMMT_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      Multiple nominations validation method                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOMPRORATE_VAL       I VALIDATION                    Proration Validation Method                                 .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_CHK              I OIJ_NOM_CHECK_CONFIRM         Checkin confirmation status for related customer nominations.
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_COMM_ALE         I CONTROL_RECORD_OUT            Enhancement to control record output                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_COMM_RECEIVE     I PREPROCESSING                 Preprocessing Receive Partner Communication Information     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_DEFAULTING       I DEFAULTING_POSTPROCESSING     Nomination Defaulting Post Processing                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_DEFAULTING       I DEFAULTING_PREPROCESSING      Nomination Defaulting Pre Processing                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_DEF_DUMMLOC      I DEFAULT_LOC                   defaults dummy location id for bunker conumption            .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_EVPREREQ         I PREREQUISITE_CHECK            Event prerequisite check                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_EVSUBSEQ         I SUBSEQUENT_EVENT              Subsequent event routine                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FILTER           I ADD_RECORDS                   Add nominations dynamically                                 .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FILTER           I FILTER                        Nomination output table filter routine                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FOR_LOC_DMND     I DETERMINE_ROUTE               Determine route                                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FOR_LOC_DMND     I MANIPULATE_COMPILED_ITEMS     Manipulate nomination items for demands                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FOR_LOC_DMND     I MANIPULATE_DEMAND_DATA        Manipulate incoming demand data                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_FOR_LOC_DMND     I MANIPULATE_SELECTION_CRITERIA Extend selection criteria for retrivieng nominations on DB  .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I EVENT_MASS_CHANGE             Mathod at Event mass change                                 .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I FCODE_TICKET                  Create Ticket out of Nomination                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I FILL_DISPLAY_DATA             Fill nomination display data                                .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I ITEM_CHANGE                   Method at item change                                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I ITEM_COPY                     Method at item copy                                         .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I NODE_SELECT                   Method on tree node selection                               .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I NOMINATION_CREATE_BY_REF      Method at create by reference                               .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_GUI              I NOMINATION_STARTUP            Method at nomination startup                                .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MAINTAIN         I DATABASE_UPDATES              Exit Method called at update module invocation              .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MAINTAIN         I DATABASE_UPDATE_PREPROCESSING Preprocessing for the database updates                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MAINTAIN         I FIELDSTATUS_DETERMINE         Determine Field Status for Customer-Defined Fields          .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MAINTAIN         I NOMNR_PRESET                  Preset Nomination Number in Create Mode                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MAINTAIN         I STDFIELDSTATUS_DETERMINE      Determine Field Status for Standard Fields                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_MATBALANCE       I BALANCE                       Re-create balance on pushbutton function of the GUI         .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_PIPE_BATCH       I PIPE_BATCH_MODIFY             Method to modify pipe batch line items before display       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_PIPE_BATCH       I PIPE_BATCH_RECALCULATE        Method to recalculate pipe batch times automatically        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_PIPE_BATCH       I STAGES_TOLERANCE_GET          Method to specify the allowed tolerance for stages duration..
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_PUBLISH          I ITEM_CHANGE                   Method at item change                                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_STPREREQ         I PREREQUISITE_CHECK            Status prerequisite check                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_STSUBSEQ         I SUBSEQUENT_STATUS             Subsequent status routine                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I COMM_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY        adjust ui for communication ALV                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I CUST_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY        adjust ui: customer nomination ALV                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I DOCFLOW_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY     adjust ui: docflow ALV                                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I EVENT_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY       adjust ui: event ALV                                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I MAT_BAL_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY     adjust ui: materail balance ALV                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I NOM_ALV_BUTTON                adjust non-standard buttons of item overview ALV            .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I NOM_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY         adjust ui: nomination item overview ALV                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I NOM_ALV_HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU   adjust context menu of item overview ALV                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I NOM_ALV_HANDLE_FCODE          handle user fcode (button / context menu)                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I SEL_TREE_FIRST_DISPLAY        adjust ui: selection tree                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I SEL_TREE_HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU  adjust context menu of selection tree                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I STAGES_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY      adjust ui: stages ALV                                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I TICKET_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY      adjust ui: ticket document ALV                              .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I TICKET_ALV_REFRESH_DISPLAY    Validate ALV to adjust field values                         .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I TOGGLE_SCREEN_AT_STARTUP      preset toggle state of screen at startup                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UI               I VIEW_TREE_FIRST_DISPLAY       adjust ui: view tree                                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPDATE           I NOMNR_PRESET                  Preset Nomination Number in Create Mode                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPDATE           I STO_CREATE                    Create STO                                                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I CALCULATE                     Calculate Schedule lines (standard logic)                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I CALCULATE_ITEM                Calculate Items (standard logic)                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_MM                     Update MM Documents (e.g. Items / Schedule Lines)           .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_MM_ITEM                Update Items of Purchase Documents                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_MM_SCHEDLN             Update Schedule lines of Purchase Order                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_REQ                    Update Items of Requisition documents                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_SD                     Update SD Documents (e.g. Items / Schedule Lines)           .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_SD_ITEM                Update Items of Sales Documents                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_UPD_SCHEDLN      I UPDATE_SD_SCHEDLN             Update Schedule lines of Sales Order                        .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_VALIDATION       I VALIDATE                      Item validation method                                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_NOM_VIEW_CHECK       I VALIDATE                      Check the selected nomination view                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_PEG_GUI              I AMMEND_OUTTAB                 Ammend the Pegging tree outtab                              .
IF_EX_OIJ_PEG_RULE             I AUTO_PEGGING                  Auto-Pegging                                                .
IF_EX_OIJ_PEG_RULE             I VALIDATE                      Pegging validation method                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_PP                   I GET_PPTYPE_CUST               Get data from PP customer source                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_PP                   I GET_PPTYPE_S021               Adjust S021 fields                                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_PP                   I GET_PPTYPE_S022               Adjust S022 fields                                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_PP                   I UPDATE_PREPROCESSING          Customer specific processing                                .
IF_EX_OIJ_PRO_TKT_O1           I CALCULATE                     Calculation of Temperature of Loaded Quantity in the Ticket .
IF_EX_OIJ_QUERY                I PREPARE_QUERY_CALL            Prepare selection variables for Query Call                  .
IF_EX_OIJ_RD_BASE_DATE         I DETERMINE_RD_BASE_DATE        Method to overwrite SAP Base date                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_RD_CONSTR            I OIJ_RD_CONSTR_VALID           Constraints validation                                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_RD_ZONLO             I RD_PHYINV_SET_ZONLO           Time zone  setting for physical inventory                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_REP_QTY              I REP_QTY_01                    Report quantities into Inventory                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_REP_QTY              I REP_QTY_02                    Update reported q'ties into internal rundown table          .
IF_EX_OIJ_ROIJRDU1N            I SP_BALANCE                    Fiddle with Balance indicator to suppress/show balance line .
IF_EX_OIJ_SCHED                I GET_DEFAULT                   Get the default SITYP and DOCIND                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_SCHED                I SPLIT_QS                      Breakdown of contract quantities                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_SCHED_BREAKDOWN      I BREAKDOWN                     Breakdown OIJ_SCHED items                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_SCHED_UPDATE         I MODIFY_SCHED_UPDATE           Exit to allow customer control on SCHED updates             .
IF_EX_OIJ_SPREL                I OIJ_SPREL                     Stock projection relevance break-down of contract quantities.
IF_EX_OIJ_SPREL                I OIJ_SPREL_CONSUMPT            SP relevance: consumption of contracts by nominations       .
IF_EX_OIJ_SPREL                I OIJ_SPREL_DELETE              SP relevance: delete quantity schedules                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_SPREL                I OIJ_SPREL_QT_UPDATE           BADI called from quotation update                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_SPTYPE_SIMAPPL       I ASSOCIATE_SPTYPE_TO_SIM       Overwrite SP type -" Sim. Application association           .
IF_EX_OIJ_SP_DOC               I GET_DEFAULT                   Get the default SITYP and DOCIND                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_SP_DOC               I SET_ISSUE_RECEIPT_INDICATOR   Determine the issue / receipt indicator in the SP           .
IF_EX_OIJ_SS_CALC              I CALC_SHIP_SHORE_DIFF          Shipshore calculation routine                               .
IF_EX_OIJ_STOP_GAUGE_CALC      I CALC_STOP_GAUGE               calculates stop gauge given start gauge and LD qty          .
IF_EX_OIJ_STOP_METER_CALC      I CALC_STOP_METER               calculates stop meter given start meter and transported qty..
IF_EX_OIJ_STOP_MTR_CALC        I CALC_STOP_METER               calculates stop meter given start meter and transported qty..
IF_EX_OIJ_TIMECONS             I AGG_TANK_CONSTRAINTS          Aggregate tank constraints into Location constraints        .
IF_EX_OIJ_TIMECONS             I UPLOAD_TIMECONS               Upload time dependent constraints from external system      .
IF_EX_OIJ_TIMEZONE_CALC        I DATE_TIME_TO_TIMESTAMP        Convert Date and Time into UTC Timestamp                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_TIMEZONE_CALC        I TIMESTAMP_TO_DATE_TIME        Convert UTC Timestamp into Date and Time                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I ACTUALIZATION_CHECK           Ticket actualization checks                                 .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I AUTHORIZE_ACTUALIZATION       Disable Actualize button based on checks                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I CHANGE_SEQUENCE               Changes the sequence in T_TICKET_ITEM                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I CHECK_INCOMPL_CRPT_TKT        Check incompletion in document reversal for corrupt tickets .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I CIP_STEPS_CHECK               CIP step checks                                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I DOCFLOW_PREPROCESSING         Ticket Docflow add in                                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I DOCUMENT_GENERATION           Ticket actualization add in                                 .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I DOCUMENT_GENERATION_N         Ticket actualization add in (new)                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I GET_ACCOUNTINFO               Get the Customer's Account Information                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I IDOC_FIELDTRANSFER            Ticket Idoc Fieldmapping add in                             .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I SET_IO                        Set Dynpro fields                                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_DEFAULTS_SET           Set Ticket Default Data                                     .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_DEFAULT_VSTEL          Default Shipping point for Ticket item                      .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_MAINTENANCE_CUSTACTION Ticket Maintenance add in Customer activities               .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_MAINTENANCE_POSTPROCESSTicket Maintenance add in                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_MAINTENANCE_PREPROCESS Ticket Maintenance add in                                   .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_VALIDATION             Ticket Validations within actualization processing          .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I TICKET_VALIDATION_N           Ticket Validations                                          .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT                  I VALIDATE_TICKET_QUANTITY      Ticket quantity tolerance validations                       .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKTHD_VALIDATION     I VALIDATE                      Header validation method                                    .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_DEFAULTING       I DEFAULTING_POSTPROCESSING     Ticket Defaulting Post Processing                           .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_DEFAULTING       I DEFAULTING_PREPROCESSING      Ticket Defaulting Pre Processing                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_DOCG             I AUTO_CLOSE_NOM_TOLERANCES     Auto close behaviour of nomination based on the tolerances. .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_DOCG             I SET_POSTINGDATE_REV_GI        Set Posting Date within Reversal Material Document          .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_DOCG             I SET_POSTINGDATE_REV_GR        Set Posting Date within Reversal Material Document          .
IF_EX_OIJ_TKT_GEN_CONITEMS     I CHECK_PENDING_ITEM            Checks Ticket Items for Dependend Items (e.g. consumption)  .
IF_EX_OIJ_TSW_EXT_DETAILS      I MM_EXT_DETAILS                Handle MM external details in ticketing / actualization     .
IF_EX_OIJ_TSW_EXT_DETAILS      I SD_EXT_DETAILS                Handle SD external details in ticketing / actualization     .
IF_EX_OIJ_UPDATE_3P_ITEMS      I UPDATE_3P_ITEMS               Reference Document changes update SCHED_STAT = '3P' items   .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I CLIPBOARD_ALV_BUTTON          remove buttons from / add custom buttons to the What-If CLB .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I CLIPBOARD_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY   set properties of the fields in the What-If CLB table       .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I CLIPBOARD_ALV_HANDLE_FCODE    handle customer function codes for the What-If CLB          .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I CLIPBOARD_ALV_REFRESH_DISPLAY refresh properties of the fields in the What-If CLB table   .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I POPUP_ALV_BUTTON              remove buttons from / add custom buttons to the What-If popu.
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I POPUP_ALV_FIRST_DISPLAY       set properties of the fields in the What-If output table    .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I POPUP_ALV_HANDLE_FCODE        handle customer function codes for the What-If popup        .
IF_EX_OIJ_WHATIF_UI            I POPUP_ALV_REFRESH_DISPLAY     refresh properties of the fields in the What-If output table.
IF_EX_OIJ_WHIF_DISAGG_RULE     I WHATIF_DISAGG_RULE            What-if type Disaggregation rule                            .
IF_EX_OIJ_WL                   I OIJ_WL_RD_SELECT              Worklist engine: overwrite selection from SAPMOIJRD         .
IF_EX_OIJ_WL_NOMI_CHK_TOL      I NOMI_CHK_TOL                  Nomination check tolerance                                  .
IF_EX_OIK_SHPPL                I GETDETAIL_POSTPROCESSING      Outbound processing                                         .
IF_EX_OIK_SHPPL                I GETDETAIL_PREPROCESSING       Inbound processing                                          .
IF_EX_OIK_SPLIT_QUANTITY       I SPLIT_QUANTITY                Split the order item quantiy                                .
IF_EX_OIO_CONTAINER            I CONTAINER_USAGE               Check container usage                                       .
IF_EX_OIO_CONTAINER            I FIELD_TRANSPORT_PM_EQUIPMENT  Transport fields from PM equipment                          .
IF_EX_OIO_CROSS_DOCK_LIST      I MODIFY_LIST_LINE              Modify line in cross docking list                           .
IF_EX_OIO_HOLDING              I DEF_HOLD_OPERATION            Set default hold status for order operation                 .
IF_EX_OIO_RENTAL_MOB           I RENTAL_MOB_PAI                Rental mobilization data in "Process After Input"           .
IF_EX_OIO_RENTAL_MOB           I RENTAL_MOB_PBO                Rental mobilization data in "Process Before Output"         .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I MM_REQUISITION_CHECK          Check MM requisition for use as reference object            .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I MM_REQUISITION_MAP            Map fields from MM requisition to material return           .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PM_ORDER_CMP_CHECK            Check PM order component for use as reference object        .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PM_ORDER_CMP_MAP              Map fields from PM order component to material return       .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PM_ORDER_SVC_CHECK            Check PM order service line for use as reference object     .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PM_ORDER_SVC_MAP              Map fields from PM order service line to material return    .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PS_NETWORK_MAT_CHECK          Check PS network material for use as reference object       .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PS_NETWORK_MAT_MAP            Map fields from PS network material to material return      .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PS_NETWORK_SVC_CHECK          Check PS network service line for use as reference object   .
IF_EX_OIO_RT_REFERENCE         I PS_NETWORK_SVC_MAP            Map fields from PS network service line to material return  .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I CNTNR_BLOCK                   Block container in display                                  .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I CNTNR_CHECK                   Check container prior to update                             .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I DELIV_BLOCK                   Block delivery in display                                   .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I DELIV_CHECK                   Check delivery prior to update                              .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I SHPMT_BLOCK                   Block shipment in display                                   .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPMENT_RECEIPT     I SHPMT_CHECK                   Check shipment prior to update                              .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_CONTAINER               Check container                                             .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_CONTENTS                Check container contents                                    .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_MOVE_CNTNR_TO_SHPMT     Check container may be moved to shipment                    .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_MOVE_DLVRY_TO_CNTNR     Check delivery may be moved to container                    .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_UPDATE_CONTAINER        Check container assignment in packing update                .
IF_EX_OIO_SHIPPING             I CHECK_UPDATE_DELIVERY         Check delivery assignment in packing update                 .
IF_EX_OIO_SH_CAPACITY          I TRANSPORT_UNIT_CAPACITY       Change capacity for a transport unit                        .
IF_EX_OIO_SH_CAPACITY          I VOYAGE_CAPACITY               Determine capacity from voyage number                       .
IF_EX_OIO_SH_ROUTE             I HANDLING_UNIT_ROUTE           Set departure and destination point                         .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I CONVERT_TRANSPORT_REQN        Field transport from transport reqn to purchase reqn        .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DECIDE_TR_REQ_CONVERSION      Decide conversion requirements for transport requisition    .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DETERMINE_ITEM_CATEGORY       Determine item category                                     .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DETERMINE_PROCESS             Determine supply process                                    .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DETERMINE_SLOC_BOM            Determine store location during BOM explosion               .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DETERMINE_SUPPLY_PLANT        Determine supply plant                                      .
IF_EX_OIO_SUPPLY_CHAIN         I DETERMINE_SUPPLY_TYPE         Determine supply type                                       .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_CHILDREN                Check children of parent document object                    .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_DISPLAY                 Change the tracking object before list output               .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_FLOW                    Amend hierachy flow before manipulation                     .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_HIERARCHY               Amend completed hierarchy                                   .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_LIST                    Check tracking object during hierarchy list output          .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I CHECK_OBJECT                  Check tracking object status                                .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete object                                               .
IF_EX_OIO_TRACKING             I HIDE_OBJECT                   Hide object                                                 .
IF_EX_OIO_VG_SHIPMENT          I FIELD_MAPPING                 Map voyage fields to shipment header                        .
IF_EX_OIO_VOYAGE               I CHECK_FIELDS                  Check fields when saving the voyage                         .
IF_EX_OIO_VOYAGE               I DEFAULT_FIELDS                Default screen fields for voyage master                     .
IF_EX_OIRA_AFTER_EXECUTION     I PROCESS_AFTER_EXECUTION       Process execution                                           .
IF_EX_OIRA_DBT_INS_CONCAT      I INSERT                        Process record for insertion into aggregartion table        .
IF_EX_OIRA_DBT_MOD_CONCAT      I MODIFY                        Process record for modification to aggregartion table       .
IF_EX_OIRA_IN                  I INAGGRO                       Fill data into aggregated table                             .
IF_EX_OIRA_MSG_SUPP            I SUPPRESS_MESSAGE              Message suppression                                         .
IF_EX_OIRA_PRDISPALV           I FILLALV                       Fill customer appended fields for Print ALV display         .
IF_EX_OIRA_PREAGG_IN           I INBADI                        Fill data into variable key of pre-aggro table              .
IF_EX_OIRA_PREAGG_MAIN         I POSTAGGRO                     Manipulate DBT internal table after aggregation             .
IF_EX_OIRA_PRINT_COMM          I OIRA_FILL_SSR_COMMSTR         Fill SSR output determination comm str via BADI             .
IF_EX_OIRA_PRINT_FILL          I INBADI                        Fill data into the variable fields of the print index table .
IF_EX_OIRA_PRINT_UPDATE        I SKIP_UPDATE                   Skip update of print index                                  .
IF_EX_OIRA_PROCDATECHECK       I PROCESS_DATE_CHECK            Process date check routine                                  .
IF_EX_OIRA_PROCEXECUTION       I PROCESS_EXECUTE               Process execution                                           .
IF_EX_OIRA_PROCGRPCHECK        I PROCESS_PREREQ_GROUP_CHEC     Prerequisite grouping check                                 .
IF_EX_OIRA_PROCPREREQCHECK     I PROCESS_PREREQ_CHECK          Process prerequisite check                                  .
IF_EX_OIRA_PROCSTATUPDATE      I PROCESS_STATUS_UPDATE         Process status update routine                               .
IF_EX_OIRA_PRPROCALV           I FILLALV                       Fill customer appended fields for Print ALV display         .
IF_EX_OIRA_UPD_PRNINDEX        I MODIFY_PRNINDEX               Modify the print index entries before insert/update to DB   .
IF_EX_OIRB_STATUS              I STATUS_CHECK                  Status check routine for changing a status end date         .
IF_EX_OIRC_2DPRICE_LCDIFF      I ADD_PRICE_DIFFERENCES         Add price differences during line copy                      .
IF_EX_OIRC_CLUSTERUPDATE       I CLUSTER_PROPOSAL              Create cluster based price proposal                         .
IF_EX_OIRC_CUST_RESET          I SPECIFY_CELLS                 Specify cells BADI                                          .
IF_EX_OIRC_DR_SCHDEF           I DR_SCHEDULE                   Check the dip readings process schedule                     .
IF_EX_OIRC_DR_TOLQTY           I DETERMINE_TOLERANCE_QTY       Determines the base quantity to calculate the tolerance.    .
IF_EX_OIRC_DR_USERCHK          I DR_USER_CHECKS                Define dip readings upload user checks                      .
IF_EX_OIRC_EDITMATRIX          I EDIT_MATRIX                   Edit Matrix BADI                                            .
IF_EX_OIRC_FOOTERDEFN          I DEFINE_FOOTER                 Define Footer                                               .
IF_EX_OIRC_HEADERDEFN          I DEFINE_HEADER                 Define pricing dialog header structure                      .
IF_EX_OIRC_LOGDOCDR_SCHDEF     I LOGDOCDR_SCHEDULE             Check the logistics document process schedule (Dip reading) .
IF_EX_OIRC_LOGDOC_SCHDEF       I LOGDOC_SCHEDULE               Check the logistics document process schedule               .
IF_EX_OIRC_MARGINDEFN          I DEFINE_MARGIN                 Margine Analysis Definition                                 .
IF_EX_OIRC_MR_EVNT_AGGEXCL     I MR_EVNT_AGGEXCL               Plug the Code to Exclude MR Aggregation for Certain Events  .
IF_EX_OIRC_MR_MANUAL_PR        I MR_MANUAL_PROCESS             Manual meter reading entry - Steps before save              .
IF_EX_OIRC_MR_SCHDEF           I MR_SCHEDULE                   Check the meter readings process schedule                   .
IF_EX_OIRC_MR_USERCHK          I MR_USER_CHECKS                Define meter readings upload user checks                    .
IF_EX_OIRC_OUT                 I OUTAGGRO                      Transfer vakey components from aggregated table             .
IF_EX_OIRC_PERIODDEFN          I DEFINE_PERIOD                 Period definition method                                    .
IF_EX_OIRC_PRICECOMMSTR        I FILL_COMM_STRUCTURE           Fill pricing communication strucure                         .
IF_EX_OIRC_PRICEPROPDOWN       I CREATE_COL_PROPOSAL           Create columnwise price proposal                            .
IF_EX_OIRC_PRICEPROPOSAL       I CREATE_PROPOSAL               Create rowwise price proposal                               .
IF_EX_OIRC_PRREPORTCOMMSTR     I FILL_OIRCPISPC_STRUCTURE      Fill OIRCPISPC communication structure                      .
IF_EX_OIRC_PR_HISTSEL          I PR_HISTORY_SELECTION          Select and display price history records                    .
IF_EX_OIRC_PR_SAVE             I PRICE_SAVE_ACTIONS            SSR Pricing - Actions after save command                    .
IF_EX_OIRC_PR_USERCHK          I PR_USER_CHECKS                Define SSR Pricing user checks                              .
IF_EX_OIRC_REPRICE_CHECK       I PROCESS_MOVEMENT_CHECK        Check if material movements require repricing               .
IF_EX_OIRC_RESET_CELLS         I DEFINE_CELLS                  Define cells for reset                                      .
IF_EX_OIRC_ROLLOVER_CNTR       I MR_ROLLOVER_CONTROL           SSR Meters - Rollover control                               .
IF_EX_OIRC_ROWDEFN             I DEFINE_ROW                    Define pricing row                                          .
IF_EX_OIRC_SCREENDEFN          I DEFINE_SCREEN                 Define Pricing screen structure                             .
IF_EX_OIRC_TARGET_LINE         I DEFINE_TARGET_LINE            Define target line                                          .
IF_EX_OIRE_CHCALENDAR          I CALENDAR_CHECK                check calendar to see if settlement/transm'n is to be done  .
IF_EX_OIRE_CHDISCOUNTS         I DISCOUNTS                     detemine # discount-qualifying transactions                 .
IF_EX_OIRE_CHDISP_ALV_DTF      I FILL_ALV                      Fill customer appended fields for DTF ALV display           .
IF_EX_OIRE_CHDISP_ALV_REC      I FILL_ALV                      Fill additional customer fields in ALV display of recon data.
IF_EX_OIRE_CHPROCALV           I FILLALV                       Fill customer appended fields for CH ALV display            .
IF_EX_OIRE_COMP                I COMPLAINT                     Payment card complaint processing                           .
IF_EX_OIRE_COMPLAINTPROC       I COMPLAINT_ACTION              Create DBT/DTF entries for complaint actions                .
IF_EX_OIRE_DTF_CMPLETE_DEF     I INCOMPLETION_CHECK            Incompletion check for PC transactions                      .
IF_EX_OIRE_DTF_ITM_PRICE       I MATERIAL_UNIT_HANDLING        DTF item material unit handling                             .
IF_EX_OIRE_DTF_ITM_PRICE       I PRICE_UNIT_HANDLING           DTF item price unit handling                                .
IF_EX_OIRE_DTF_ITM_STYP        I SERVICE_TYPE_HANDLING         DTF: service type handling on item level                    .
IF_EX_OIRE_DTF_SAVE            I DTF_SAVE                      User Exit Before the Payment Card Data Is Saved             .
IF_EX_OIRE_FILL_COMM_STR       I FILL_COMM_FOR_CHDIS           Fill the comm. structures for the CH discount               .
IF_EX_OIRE_FILL_COMM_STR       I FILL_COMM_STRUCTURES          Fill the communication structures for pricing               .
IF_EX_OIRE_PCSTAT              I PCSTATS                       Fill dynamically determined PC stats                        .
IF_EX_OIRE_RECON_ALV           I FILLALV                       Fill customer defined fields in ALV CH upload summary       .
IF_EX_OIRE_RECON_DIFFTOL       I GET_DIFFTOL_RESULT            Determine whether the differences are acceptable or not     .
IF_EX_OIRE_RECON_DTF_MODIF     I MODIFY_DTF_SEL_PARAMS         Modify the selection parameters used for OIRE_READ_DTF      .
IF_EX_OIRE_RECON_PROPOSE       I RECON_LOGIC_EXECUTE           Execute Reconciliation Proposal Logic                       .
IF_EX_OIRE_SPLIT               I SPLITTING                     Payment card splitting                                      .
IF_EX_OIRE_VAL                 I VALIDATION                    Payment card validation                                     .
IF_EX_OIRH_BL                  I GETDETAIL_POSTPROCESSING      Metod for outbound processing of Business location data     .
IF_EX_OIRH_BL                  I GETDETAIL_PREPROCESSING       Inbound processing of Business location data                .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLD                 I GETDETAIL_POSTPROCESSING      Changing parameter structures BAPIBULOCD02                  .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLD                 I GETDETAIL_PREPROCESSING       Changing parameter structures BAPIBULOCD01                  .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLD                 I SAVEMULTIPLE_PREPROCESSING    Changing table parameter structure BAPIBULOCD03             .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLM                 I GETDETAIL_POSTPROCESSING      Changing parameter structures BAPIBULOCM02                  .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLM                 I GETDETAIL_PREPROCESSING       Changing parameter structures BAPIBULOCM01                  .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLM                 I SAVEMULTIPLE_PREPROCESSING    Changing table parameter structure BAPIBULOCM03             .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLP                 I COMPARE_PRICES_PREPROCESSING  Changing table parameter structures BAPIBULOCP08            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLP                 I GETLIST_POSTPROCESSING        Changing table parameter structures BAPIBULOCP02            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLP                 I GETLIST_PREPROCESSING         Changing table parameter structures BAPIBULOCP01            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLP                 I SAVE_CMPSRVY_PREPROCESSING    Changing table parameter structures BAPIBULOCP04            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLP                 I SAVE_MULTIPLE_PREPROCESSING   Changing table parameter structures BAPIBULOCP03            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLPCP               I CONV_RECON_AGG                Convert the aggregated reconciliation data (BAPI            .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLPCP               I CONV_RECON_DET                Convert the detailed reconciliation data (BAPI              .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLPCP               I UPLOAD_PREPROCESSING          Changing parameter structrues BAPIBULOCP02                  .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLPCP_AGG           I GET_PROCID                    Get process ID for process status update                    .
IF_EX_OIRH_BLPCP_PRNO          I GET_PROCID                    Get process ID for payment card upload                      .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I DTF_HEADER_TRANSFER           Business Add-In to transfer customer DTF header fields      .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I DTF_ITEM_TRANSFER             Business Add-In to transfer customer DTF item fields        .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I MESSAGE_POSTPROCESSING        Business Add-In for entire message postprocessing           .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0001_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0001 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0002_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0002 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0003_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0003 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0004_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0004 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0005_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0005 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0006_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0006 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0007_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0007 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0008_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0008 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_01     I SEGMENT_0009_POSTPROCESSING   Business Add-In for Segment 0009 post processing            .
IF_EX_OIRH_CHS_OUTBOUND_02     I TRANSMISSION_LOG_AMENDMENT    Change to Transmissin log                                   .
IF_EX_OIRH_RECON               I CONV_RECON_AGG                Upload the aggregated reconciliation data                   .
IF_EX_OIRH_RECON               I CONV_RECON_DET                Upload the detailed reconciliation data                     .
IF_EX_OIRI_ADDINVDATA          I ADDINVDATA                    Add ...                                                     .
IF_EX_OIRI_ADD_DATA            I ADD_DATA                      Add ...                                                     .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I ADD_DOCUMENT_INFO             Manipulation before adding a document line                  .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I ADD_FUELS_COMMISSION_INFO     Manipulation before adding a fuels information line         .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I ADD_FUELS_INFO                Manipulation before adding a fuels information line         .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I ADD_PC_INFO                   Manipulation before adding a payment card information line  .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I ADD_SUMMARY_INFO              Manipulation before adding a summary information line       .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I BUILD_SUMM_INFO               Build up monthly and daily summarizations                   .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I DOUBLE_CLICK                  Event performed at double-click on mothly/daily aggr.node   .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I MODIFY_FIELDCATALOG           Manipulation of field catalog                               .
IF_EX_OIRI_DAILY               I MODIFY_INDICES                Manipulation of index table                                 .
IF_EX_OIRI_DEFERRED_PAYM       I ACCOUNTPOSTINGS               FI account postings process                                 .
IF_EX_OIRI_DETDOC              I DETERMINE_DOCUMENT            Determine invoicing documnet type to be produced            .
IF_EX_OIRI_DETERM_VENDOR       I VENDDET                       Determine vendor and posting keys                           .
IF_EX_OIRI_DIST                I DISTFEE                       Distribute fee to appropriate cost centres                  .
IF_EX_OIRI_FILL_COMM           I FILL_COMM                     Fill communication structures                               .
IF_EX_OIRI_LIS_UPDATES         I PROCESSLIS                    Call LIS update programs                                    .
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I CALCULATE_MARGINS             Calculate margin elements                                   .
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I DETERMINE_MARGIN_NAMES        Determines the names of the margin fields                   .
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I DETERMINE_MATNR_COL_ASSGNMNT  Determines the assignments of materials/columns             .
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I DETERMINE_REL_MRGN_BASIS      Determince the basis for relative margin calculation        .
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I DETERMINE_STRUCTURE_NAME      Determines the SIS structure name, if not S412 should be use.
IF_EX_OIRI_MARGIN_CALC_REP     I FORMAT_MARGIN_SCREEN          Formatting of margin screen output table                    .
IF_EX_OIRI_OUT                 I OUTAGGRO                      Transfer vakey components from aggregated table             .
IF_EX_OIRI_PRN_DCLAIM          I PRINT_INVOICE                 Print daily claim                                           .
IF_EX_OIRI_QV_FILL             I QV_FILL                       Fill quantity and value fields                              .
IF_EX_OIRI_QV_OUT              I QV_OUT                        Transfer from quantity and value in aggro to comm struct    .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I CHANGE_LINE                   Change Line                                                 .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Node                                                 .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I CREATE_HEADING                Create Heading                                              .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I CREATE_NODES                  Create Nodes                                                .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I DOUBLE_CLICK_LINE             Double Click Line                                           .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I DOUBLE_CLICK_NODE             Double Click Node                                           .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I INSERT_LINE                   Insert Line                                                 .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I INSERT_NODE                   Insert Node                                                 .
IF_EX_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW     I REMOVE_ENTITIES               Remove Entities                                             .
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_DN                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Delivery Network.
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_FL                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Field           .
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_MP                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Measurement Pt  .
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_PR                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Property        .
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_WC                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Well Completion .
IF_EX_OIUH_X_CROSS_REF         I CONVERT_WL                    BADI for non-standard reverse conversion of Well            .
IF_EX_OIUPR_SKF_COUNT          I STORE_SKF_COUNT               Store the SKFCount Data Before Zero Counts are cleared      .
IF_EX_OIUP_ADMIN_WORKBENCH     I DELETE_DATA                   Delete PDM Data                                             .
IF_EX_OIUP_ADMIN_WORKBENCH     I GET_RECORD_COUNTS             Get Record Count(s) per DB Connection for a PMDtable        .
IF_EX_OIUP_ADMIN_WORKBENCH     I INSERT_DATA                   Insert PDM Data                                             .
IF_EX_OIUP_ADMIN_WORKBENCH     I SELECT_DATA                   Select PDM Data                                             .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I CHANGE_ITAB                   "Change" table CONNECTION dbcon FROM itab.                  .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I CHANGE_WA                     "Change" table CONNECTION dbcon FROM wa.                    .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I CHANGE_WHERE                  "Change" table CONNECTION dbcon SET... WHERE...             .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I SELECT_ENDSELECT              SELECT ... ENDSELECT.                                       .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I SELECT_ITAB                   SELECT ... INTO TABLE itab ...                              .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I SELECT_WA                     SELECT ... INTO wa ...                                      .
IF_EX_OIUP_PDM_ENGINE          I SHADOW_POPULATE               Populate Shadow Table                                       .
IF_EX_OIUREP_2014_DOC_ID       I CREATE_DOCUMENT_ID            Create Document ID                                          .
IF_EX_OIURV_CI_INCLTAXFREE     I CISUM_INCLTAXFREE             Include Tax Free for Settlemt Statement Tax Driver          .
IF_EX_OIURV_CI_SKIPREC         I CI_SKIPREC                    Set Skip Record for Settlemt Statement Tax Driver           .
IF_EX_OIURV_CI_SKIPREC_SUM     I CISUM_SKIPREC                 Set Skip Record for Settlemt Statement Tax Sum              .
IF_EX_OIURV_LD_INCLTAXFREE     I LD_INCLTAXFREE                Include Tax Free for Tax Driver                             .
IF_EX_OIURV_TAX_LD_SKIPREC     I TAX_LD_SKIPREC                Set Skip Record for Tax Sum                                 .
IF_EX_OIURV_TAX_SKIPREC        I TAX_SKIPREC                   Set Skip Record for Tax Driver                              .
IF_EX_OIURV_UOM_EXTRACT        I UOM_EXTRACT                   UOM extraction                                              .
IF_EX_OIUVL_CISUM_SKIPREC      I CISUM_SKIPREC                 Set Skip Record for Settlemt Statement Tax Sum              .
IF_EX_OIUVL_CI_INCLTAXFREE     I CISUM_INCLTAXFREE             Include Tax Free for Settlemt Statement Tax Driver          .
IF_EX_OIUVL_CI_SKIPREC         I CI_SKIPREC                    Set Skip Record for Settlemt Statement Tax Driver           .
IF_EX_OIUVL_LD_INCLTAXFREE     I LD_INCLTAXFREE                Include Tax Free for Tax Driver                             .
IF_EX_OIUVL_TAX_LD_SKIPREC     I TAX_LD_SKIPREC                Set Skip Record for Tax Sum                                 .
IF_EX_OIUVL_TAX_SKIPREC        I TAX_SKIPREC                   Set Skip Record for Tax Driver                              .
IF_EX_OLR3_CONSISTENCY         I AT_CONSISTENCY_CHECK          Customer-Specific Consistency Check                         .
IF_EX_OLR3_DATA                I AT_GET_DATA                   Customer-Specific Data Retrieval                            .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I APPL_LOG_READ                 Read Application Log                                        .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I APPL_LOG_WRITE_ERROR_MESSAGES Enter Errors from Update in Application Log                 .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I ASYNCHRONOUS_UPDATE_MODE      Switch off Asynchronous Updating for Object Links           .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I COPY_DOCUMENT_STRUCTURE       Copy Document Info Record Including Document Structure      .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I CREATENEWVRS_DOC              Create New Version for Document Info Record of Document     .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I CREATE_DOC                    Create Document Info Record as Document                     .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I CREATE_FOLDER                 Create Document Info Record as Folder                       .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I CREATE_ORIGINAL               Create Original in Document Info Record                     .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I DMS_CONSISTENCY_CHECK         Special Consistency Check for SAP DMS Document Links        .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I DOC_TYPE_IS_VALID_FOR_FOLDER  Document Category Is Valid for New cProjects Folders        .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I GET_CFX_CUST_LINK             Determine cFolders Name from Customizing                    .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I OVERWRITE_ORIGINAL            Overwrite (Update) Original in Document Info Record         .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I STATUS_CHANGE                 Status Change for a Document                                .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I UPDATE_BOM_ITEM               Create and Delete SAP DMS Document Structure Items          .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I UPDATE_OBJECT_LINK            Create, Change, and Delete DMS Object Link DPR_OBJLNK       .
IF_EX_OLR3_DMS                 I WHERE_USED_ANALYSIS           Template Document Structure Used in Other Templates         .
IF_EX_OLR3_NOTIFICATION        I FILL_VALUE_PAIRS              Customer-Internal Data Transfer for ORDNO, Fields from RIQS5.
IF_EX_OM_EDITOR                I ADJUST_CHAR_GROUP             Supply Grouping Field for VS Tree                           .
IF_EX_OM_EDITOR                I AFTER_CHANGE                  Supply additional fields after a dependency change          .
IF_EX_OM_EDITOR                I BRACKET_SOURCE                Method for customer-specific compounding                    .
IF_EX_OM_EDITOR                I CUST_SYNTAX_CHECK             Method for Customer-Specific Syntax Check                   .
IF_EX_OM_EDITOR                I SELECT_HIST_VS                Determine Customer-Specific Historical Variance Scheme      .
IF_EX_OPENHUB_TRANSFORM        I TRANSFORM                     Transformation of Extracted Data into Transferred Data      .
IF_EX_ORDER_COSTING_CK         I ON_ORDER_COSTING              Header Data Manipulation Before Preliminary Order Costing   .
IF_EX_ORDER_COSTING_CK         I ON_ORDER_COSTING_DISPLAY      Header Data Manipulation Display Preliminary Order Costing  .
IF_EX_OXT_BUSOBJ_DEF           I ADD_OBJECTS                   Add EEW Business Objects                                    .
IF_EX_OXT_BUSOBJ_DEF           I DEACTIVATE_OBJECTS            Delete EEW Business Objects                                 .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPCUEMJ0           I CALCULATE_FAMILY_ALLOWANCE    Calculate Family Allowance                                  .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLHULJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Loss form data file for HI union       .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLHUOJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Acq. form data file for HI union       .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLPFLJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Loss form data file for Pens. fund     .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLPFOJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Acq. form data file for Pens. fund     .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLSHAJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Addr. chg form data file for SI office .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLSHLJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Loss form data file for SI office      .
IF_EX_PADJP_RPLSHOJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Acq. form data file for SI office      .
IF_EX_PARTNER_UPDATE           I CHANGE_BEFORE_OUTBOUND        BP Was Created or Changed but Not Sent                      .
IF_EX_PARTNER_UPDATE           I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Business Partner Created or Changed                         .
IF_EX_PAYJP_EADJ0_MNCPL_FD     I SET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS         Set municipal city dependent fields for payment form (FD)   .
IF_EX_PAYJP_EAD_MUNIC_FD       I CHANGE_DATA_FILE_CONTENTS     Change data file content of tax statement by DME (municipal).
IF_EX_PAYJP_EAD_MUNIC_FD       I SET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS         Set additional fields of tax statement by DME (municipal)   .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCHUBJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Shoyo payt form data file for HI union .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCHUGJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of GEPPEN form data file for HI union     .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCHUSJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of SANTEI form data file for HI union     .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCPFBJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Shoyo payt form data file for Pens.fund.
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCPFGJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of GEPPEN form data file for Pens. fund   .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCPFSJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of SANTEI form data file for Pens. fund   .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCSHBJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of Shoyo payt form data file for SI office.
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCSHGJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of GEPPEN form data file for SI office    .
IF_EX_PAYJP_RPCSHSJ0           I EDIT_RECORDS                  Edit data records of SANTEI form data file for SI office    .
IF_EX_PAYJP_SK_FACTORING       I CHECK_FACTORING_RELEVANT      Check whether factoring relevant WT                         .
IF_EX_PAYJP_SK_FACTORING       I GET_PRORATED_AMOUNT           Get prorated amount for virtual factoring                   .
IF_EX_PAYJP_SK_PRORATION       I GET_PRORATED_FLAT_AMOUNT      Get prorated flat amount                                    .
IF_EX_PAYMENTREQUEST           I PRQ_PAY_REPORTS               Changing of Reports/Variants for Scheduling During Payment  .
IF_EX_PBEN0006                 I GET_FROM_FEATURE_ELIGR        Enhancement for Determining Eligibility Grouping            .
IF_EX_PBEN0008                 I CALC_BENEFIT_COST             Enhancement for the calculation of the benefit costs        .
IF_EX_PBEN0009                 I CALC_BENEFIT_CREDIT           Enhancement for the calculation of the credit amount        .
IF_EX_PBEN0010                 I CALC_BENEFIT_SALARY           Enhancement for the calculation of the benefit salary       .
IF_EX_PBEN0011                 I CALC_COVERAGE_AMOUNT          Enhancement for the calculation of insurance coverage       .
IF_EX_PBEN0014                 I CALC_BENEFIT_ER_CONTRIB       Enhancement for determining the employer contribution       .
IF_EX_PBEN0016                 I CALC_PARTICIPATION_DATE       Enhancement for the calculation of the participation date   .
IF_EX_PBEN0028                 I CALC_BENEFIT_EE_CONTRIB       Enhancement for determining the employee contribution       .
IF_EX_PBEN0031                 I GET_POSS_DEPENDENTS           Alternative for subroutine SAP_GET_POSS_DEPENDENTS          .
IF_EX_PBEN0032                 I CHECK_DEPENDENTS              Alternative for Subroutine SAP_CHECK_DEPENDENTS             .
IF_EX_PBEN0034                 I GET_FAMILY_MEMBER_DATA        Reading Country-Specific Data for Family Member             .
IF_EX_PBEN0035                 I CHECK_DEPENDENTS              Additional Consistency Check for Dependents                 .
IF_EX_PBEN0036                 I CHECK_BENEFICIARIES           Additional Consisteny Check for Beneficiaries               .
IF_EX_PBEN0037                 I HANDLE_MISSING_SPOUSE_PARTNER Handling missing spouse/partner information                 .
IF_EX_PBENCA_PAY0001           I PROCESS_AFTER_PROVIDE         Processing after PROVIDE                                    .
IF_EX_PBENUSPS_PAY0008         I CUSTOMER_LIMIT_CALCULATION    Process EE contribution limit                               .
IF_EX_PBENUSPS_PAY0009         I PROCESS_INVESTMENT_OPTIONS    Splits 403b Contributions among Investment Options          .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0001           I CUSTOMER_CHECK_CATCHUP_ELIG   Check EE eligibility for Catch-up                           .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0002           I CUSTOMER_PROCESS_EE_CATCHUP   Process EE Catch-up contribution                            .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0003           I CUSTOMER_PROCESS_ER_CATCHUP   Process ER Catch-up contribution                            .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0004           I SET_COLLECT_EXEMPT_UGTLI      Sets Collection and Exemption flags in UGTLI                .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0005           I CALC_COVERAGE_COST_UGTLI      Calculates Coverage and Cost                                .
IF_EX_PBENUS_PAY0006           I EVALUATE_URATE_UGTLI          EVALUATES URATE FOR UGTLI                                   .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0001             I INITIALIZE_VALUES             Initialization of values before PROVIDE                     .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0002             I PROCESS_AFTER_PROVIDE         Processing after PROVIDE                                    .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0003             I PROPOSE_MODEL                 Deduction model default                                     .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0004             I EVALUATE_TIME_UNIT            Determination of time unit                                  .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0005             I EVALUATE_EE_CONTRIB           Determination of employee contribution                      .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0006             I EVALUATE_EE_CONTRIB_FIX       Determination of Employee Contribution for Fixed Periods    .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0007             I EVALUATE_ER_CONTRIB           Determination of employer contribution                      .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0008             I CHECK_CONTRIBUTION_LIMITS     Checking contribution limits                                .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0009             I GET_CURRENT_SALARY            Determination of salary for benefits calculations           .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0010             I PRORATION                     Proration processing in Benefits                            .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0011             I PROCESS_COVERAGE_AMOUNT       Processing of insurance coverage total                      .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0012             I PROCESS_INVESTMENTS           Processing of investments                                   .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0013             I INITIALIZE_VALUES_PER_PLAN    Initialize plan specific values                             .
IF_EX_PBEN_PAY0015             I PRORATING_BY_WORKING_DAY      Prorating by working_day                                    .
IF_EX_PBSAUHDA                 I CALC_HDA_PAYSCALE             Decide which payscale is the foundation for increment       .
IF_EX_PBSAUHDA                 I CALC_HDA_PERIOD               Pick up suitable HDA performing periods                     .
IF_EX_PBSAUHI1                 I CALC_SENIORITY                Calculation of Seniority                                    .
IF_EX_PBSAULLM                 I CALC_NO_ABS                   Calculate number of absence                                 .
IF_EX_PBSAUTRM                 I CALC_SENIORITY                Calculation of Seniority                                    .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0001             I EXIT_REMITTANCE_ADVICE        User exit for remittance advice forms and segment text      .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0002             I EXIT_BRANCH_HEAD_VENDORS      User exit for branch to head office vendors mapping         .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0003             I APPEND_EE_DETAIL_DOC          Customize summary EE details (Customer rules)               .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0003             I BUILD_EE_DETAIL_DATA          Customize additional EE data (Customer rules)               .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0003             I GET_FIELDVALUE                Get field value                                             .
IF_EX_PC10_3PR0004             I GET_REMITTANCE_DUEDATE        Get remittance due date                                     .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0001             I OLD_BASE_WAGE                 User exit to use pbsi_10-net_wages for BSI base wages       .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0002             I ALLOW_NEG_TAXABLES            Method: Determine if negative taxables are allowed in US Tax.
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0003             I ALLOW_DIST_CALC               Method: Determine if distribution calc are allowed in US Tax.
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0004             I IS_OVERRIDE_ACTIVE            Is the revised Work Tax Area Override active?               .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0004             I SET_ACTIVATION_STATUS         Set activation status for the revised WTA Override          .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0005             I USE_OVERRIDES_BY_DEFAULT      Does the default proration of wage types use WTA overrides? .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0006             I ADJUST_BEFORE_OUTPUT          Method: Adjust display of W4 fields before output           .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0007             I VALIDATE_AFTER_INPUT          Method: Validate additional W4 fields after input           .
IF_EX_PC10_PAY0008             I GET_EXEMPTIONS                Method: Get number of exemptions to use during payroll      .
IF_EX_PC270012                 I PC270012                      User exit to get MPF voluntary contribution class number    .
IF_EX_PC280001                 I ADJUST_TAX_FORMAT             Adjust the tax format                                       .
IF_EX_PC280002                 I GET_ROUNDING_RULE             Get the PHF&SI rounding rule                                .
IF_EX_PC420001                 I CALCULATE_SENI_FOR_ALL        Calculate the seniority for all rules                       .
IF_EX_PC420002                 I SIMULATION_SELECTION          selection condition for simulation run of TW p&s report     .
IF_EX_PC420003                 I GET_BASE_SALARY               Get base salary for pension or severance                    .
IF_EX_PC420004                 I ADJUST_CALCULATED_AMOUNT      Get the final adjusted amount by customer                   .
IF_EX_PCA_BLOCK_UPDATE         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Payment Card Block was Created or Deleted                   .
IF_EX_PCA_MASTER_UPDATE        I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Payment Card was Created or Changed                         .
IF_EX_PCA_PC_HR                I SET_PROFITCENTER              Set Profit Center                                           .
IF_EX_PCLM0001                 I HR_CLM_GET_DEPENDENTS_001     Enhancement for HR_CLM_GET_DEPENDENTS                       .
IF_EX_PCNA_GRN0001             I FI_VENDOR_CHECK               Method:  Set error or warning if vendor is not found        .
IF_EX_PDCNV                    I ADAPT_CNV_STRUCTURE           Revision of Extraction Result                               .
IF_EX_PDCNV                    I ADDITIONAL_ATTRIBUTES         Other Attributes in iPPE Extraction                         .
IF_EX_PDCNV                    I ALLOCATE_DOCS_TO_ITEM         Determination of Documents for Item                         .
IF_EX_PDCNV                    I CHANGE_OPTIONS                Change to Conversion Options                                .
IF_EX_PDCNV                    I FILL_ITEM_CUSTOMER_FIELDS     Fill Customer Fields for BOM Item                           .
IF_EX_PFAIM_FILL_FLOWTYPE      I FILL_FLOWTYPE                 Fills PA Flow Type                                          .
IF_EX_PFAIM_FILL_FLOWTYPE      I GET_POSITION_FLOWTYPES        Fills the PA flow types for the creation of postions        .
IF_EX_PFBN0001                 I CALCULATE_COST                Calculate cost                                              .
IF_EX_PFBN0002                 I CALCULATE_P11D_TAX_DEFER      Calculate tax defer for p11d report                         .
IF_EX_PFBN0003                 I GET_HOLIDAY_PLAN_FACTOR       get holiday buying/selling factor                           .
IF_EX_PFBN0004                 I GET_PROCESS_DATES             Get processing dates                                        .
IF_EX_PFBN0005                 I CONV_OPTION_TIMEUNIT          Convert the time unit of  the holiday plan option           .
IF_EX_PFBN0006                 I CALC_HOLIDAY_COST             Calculate daily or hourly cost for  holiday p               .
IF_EX_PFBN0007                 I CHECK_INSURE_OPTION_DEPEN     Checking option for insurance plan for dependency           .
IF_EX_PFBN0007                 I DETERMINE_RESTRICTION_PLAN    Determing it is a restriction plan                          .
IF_EX_PFBN0007                 I RE5UCA                        Read table t5uca                                            .
IF_EX_PFBN0007                 I READ_T74_FBN17                Read insurance plan t74_fbn17                               .
IF_EX_PFBN0009                 I PRORATING_MINIMUM_SALARY      Prorating minimum salary amount                             .
IF_EX_PFBN0010                 I GET_HOLIDAY_PLAN_EVENT_FACTOR Purchase holiday for non-newhiring event                    .
IF_EX_PFO_DB_CONVERSION        I PFO_CONVERT_ATTRIBUTE         Conversion of Attribute Values for Database Access          .
IF_EX_PFO_FOA_ASSIGN           I CUSTOMER_METHOD               Execute Customer Method                                     .
IF_EX_PFO_GZO                  I GET_GZO                       Selected Business Object Assignment Data                    .
IF_EX_PFO_SEG                  I GET_SEG                       Selected Segments                                           .
IF_EX_PFO_SZO                  I GET_SZO                       Selected Business Object Assignment Data                    .
IF_EX_PI_AFS_DATA_TRANSFER     I AFS_CRS_STOCK_GET_VALUES      Extractor for variant stock info from MCHB                  .
IF_EX_PI_AFS_DATA_TRANSFER     I AFS_MAP_SKU_TO_VARIANTS       Build tables with AFS sku data and map it to variant numbers.
IF_EX_PI_AFS_DATA_TRANSFER     I AFS_PROCESS_CRM0_100          To obtain the BAPICRMDH1 information                        .
IF_EX_PI_AFS_DATA_TRANSFER     I AFS_READ_ALL_PROD_VARIANTS    To fill the configuration data for AFS variants / IPC       .
IF_EX_PI_AFS_DATA_TRANSFER     I AFS_READ_PRODUCT_VARIANT      To fill the configuration data for a AFS variant / IPC      .
IF_EX_PK_CALC_TIME             I DETERMINE_TIME                Calculate Required Time-Spot for the Summarized JIT Call    .
IF_EX_PK_CALL_INTERFACE        I GET_DATA                      Fetches the Data from the BAdI Instance                     .
IF_EX_PK_CALL_INTERFACE        I PUT_DATA                      Brings the Data to the BAdI Instance                        .
IF_EX_PK_CALL_INTERFACE        I SAVE                          Customer-Specific Data Saved                                .
IF_EX_PK_CCY_SELECTION         I CALL_DETAILED_SELECTION       Calls the Detailed Control Cycle Selection                  .
IF_EX_PK_CCY_SELECTION         I SELECT_CONTROL_CYCLES         Control Cycle Selection (Initial Screen)                    .
IF_EX_PK_REVERSAL              I EXIT_REVERSAL                 Reverse                                                     .
IF_EX_PLMIFO_ECN_MAT_STOCK     I PREPARE_MAT_DOC_HEADER        Prepare Material Document Header                            .
IF_EX_PLMIFO_ECN_MAT_STOCK     I PREPARE_MAT_DOC_ITEM          Prepare Material Document Items                             .
IF_EX_PLMIFO_MAT               I MAT_SAVE_DATA                 Possible Influence BEFORE BAPI Call in PLMIFO_MAT_SAVE      .
IF_EX_PLMIFO_MAT               I VALIDATION_ADDITIONAL_CHECKS  Other Validations in PLMIFO_MAT_VALIDATION                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I CHECK                         Check of Attributes                                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I COPY                          Transfer of Attributes When Copying Actions                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execution of a Menu Function                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Request for Context Menu in Tree                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_CREATE_MENU               Request for Create Menu in Tree                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_DEFAULT_ROLES             Transfer of Default Roles                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Request for Display Characteristics                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Transfers Field Properties to a Field                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_IMAGE                     Request for Icon                                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I GET_UI_STRUCTURE              Return of External Structure                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I IMPORT_UI_STRUCTURE_DATA      Conversion of External to Internal Structure                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I ON_CONFIRMATION               Execution of an Activity After Confirmation                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I PREPARE_OUTPUT                Preparation for Displaying Using Subscreen Call             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACTION_TYPE    I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Transfer of Attributes with Checks                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I CREATE_OBJECT                 Generate Objects                                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I CREATE_OBJECT_AT_RELEASE      Creation of Objects When Action Opened                      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Transfer Interface Function Code for Execution              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Request for Context Menu Functions                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I GET_CREATE_MENU               Request Menu with Assignment Functions                      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ACT_LINK       I GET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Request for Display Characteristics                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV            I MODIFY_FIELDCAT               Adjust Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV            I POSTPROCESS_FIELDCAT          In Addition, Change Field Catalog                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ADOPT_LAYOUT                  Adjust Layout                                               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ADOPT_TOOLBAR_EXCLUDING       Adjust Inactive Functions                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I CHANGE_FIELDCATALOG           Change in one Line of the Field Catalog                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I CHANGE_GRAPHICS               Change of a Graphic Property                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I CHANGE_HYPERLINKS             Change of Hyperlinks                                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I CHANGE_OUTTAB                 Change of One Line of Output Table                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I DETERMINE_SAVE_MODE           Determine Save Mode (S. Constant in CL_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID)  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I IS_FIELDCAT_CHANGE_REQUESTED  Should Field Catalog Be Changed?                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I IS_OUTTAB_CHANGE_REQUESTED    Should Output Table Be Changed?                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ON_BUTTON_CLICK               Handler for event BUTTON_CLICK                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ON_CONTEXT_MENU_REQUEST       Handler for Event CONTEXT_MENU_REQUEST                      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ON_MENU_BUTTON                Handler for Event MENU_BUTTON                               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ON_TOOLBAR                    Handler for Event TOOLBAR                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ALV_GRID       I ON_USER_COMMAND               Handler for Event USER_COMMAND                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_ACTION_UI_STRUCTURE       Process Surface Structure Corrective/Preventive Action      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_AUDITOBJECT_UI_STRUCTURE  Process Surface Structure Audit Object                      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_AUDITQUEST_UI_STRUCTURE   Process Surface Structure Question List for Audit           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_AUDIT_UI_STRUCTURE        Process Surface Structure Audit                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_PLAN_UI_STRUCTURE         Process Surface Structure Audit  Plan                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_QUEST_H_UI_STRUCTURE      Process Surface Structure Question List Header              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_QUEST_I_UI_STRUCTURE      Process Surface Structure Question List Item                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_APPEARANCE     I GET_ROLES_UI_STRUCTURE        Process Surface Structure Partner                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_ACTION_AT_CREATION     Change Attributes When Creating Corrective/Preventive Action.
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_ACTION_ON_COPY         Change Attributes When Copying Corrective/Preventive Action .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_AUDITQUEST_AT_CREATION Change Attributes When Creating Question List for Audit     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_AUDITQUEST_ON_COPY     Change Attributes When Copying Question List for Audit      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_AUDIT_AT_CREATION      Change Audit Attributes When Creating                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_AUDIT_ON_COPY          Change Audit Attributes When Copying                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_PLAN_AT_CREATION       Change Audit Plan Attributes When Creating                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_PLAN_ON_COPY           Change Audit Plan Attributes When Copying                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_QUEST_H_AT_CREATION    Change Question List Header Attributes When Creating        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_QUEST_H_ON_COPY        Change Question List Header Attributes When Copying         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_QUEST_I_AT_CREATION    Change Question List Item Attributes When Creating          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHANGE_QUEST_I_ON_COPY        Change Question List Item Attributes When Copying           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_ACTION_ATTRIBUTES       Check Attributes: Corrective/Preventive Action              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_AUDITQUEST_ATTRIBUTES   Check Attributes: Question List for Audit                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES        Check Attributes: Audit                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_PLAN_ATTRIBUTES         Check Attributes: Audit Plan                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_QUEST_H_ATTRIBUTES      Check Attributes: Question List Header                      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_ATTRIBUTES     I CHECK_QUEST_I_ATTRIBUTES      Check Attributes: Question List Item                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_AUDIT_AT_SAVE          Change Audit When Saving                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_AUDIT_BEFORE_UPDATE    Change Audit Before Update Task is Called                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_AUDIT_IN_UPDATE        Change Audit in Update Task                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_OBJECT_AT_SAVE         Change Audit Object When Saving                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_OBJECT_BEFORE_UPDATE   Change Audit Object Before Update Task is Called            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_OBJECT_IN_UPDATE       Change Audit Object in Update Task                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_QUEST_AT_SAVE          Change Audit Question When Saving                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_QUEST_BEFORE_UPDATE    Change Audit Question Before Update Task is Called          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CHANGE_QUEST_IN_UPDATE        Change Audit Question in Update Task                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_AUDIT_AT_SAVE          Create Audit When Saving                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_AUDIT_BEFORE_UPDATE    Create Audit Before Update Task is Called                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_AUDIT_IN_UPDATE        Create Audit in Update Task                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_OBJECT_AT_SAVE         Create Audit Object When Saving                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_OBJECT_BEFORE_UPDATE   Create Audit Object Before Update Task is Called            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_OBJECT_IN_UPDATE       Create Audit Object in Update Task                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_QUEST_AT_SAVE          Create Audit Question When Saving                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_QUEST_BEFORE_UPDATE    Create Audit Question Before Update Task is Called          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I CREATE_QUEST_IN_UPDATE        Create Audit Question in Update Task                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_AUDIT_AT_SAVE          Delete Audit When Saving                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_AUDIT_BEFORE_UPDATE    Delete Audit Before Update Task is Called                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_AUDIT_IN_UPDATE        Delete Audit in Update Task                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_OBJECT_AT_SAVE         Delete Audit Object When Saving                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_OBJECT_BEFORE_UPDATE   Delete Audit Object Before Update Task is Called            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_OBJECT_IN_UPDATE       Delete Audit Object in Update Task                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_QUEST_AT_SAVE          Delete Audit Question When Saving                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_QUEST_BEFORE_UPDATE    Delete Audit Question Before Update Task is Called          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUO_UPDATE     I DELETE_QUEST_IN_UPDATE        Delete Audit Question in Update Task                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CHANGE_PLAN_AT_SAVE           Change Plan When Saving                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CHANGE_PLAN_BEFORE_UPDATE     Change Plan Before Update Task is Called                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CHANGE_PLAN_IN_UPDATE         Change Plan in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CREATE_PLAN_AT_SAVE           Create Plan When Saving                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CREATE_PLAN_BEFORE_UPDATE     Create Plan Before Update Task is Called                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I CREATE_PLAN_IN_UPDATE         Create Plan in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I DELETE_PLAN_AT_SAVE           Delete Plan When Saving                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I DELETE_PLAN_BEFORE_UPDATE     Delete Plan Before Update Task is Called                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUP_UPDATE     I DELETE_PLAN_IN_UPDATE         Delete Plan in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUTH_CHECK     I SET_AUTHORITY_ACTIVITIES      Set Activities for Authorization                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_AUTH_CHECK     I SET_AUTH_ACTIVITIES_W_O_INST  Set Activities for Authorization Without Instances          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_BATCH_JOBS     I GET_JOBLIST                   Method of Accessing List of Jobs (Reading)                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I CALCULATE_AUDIT               Calculation of Investigation (Audit, FMEA,...)              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I CALCULATE_QUEST               Calculation of Audit Question List                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I CHECK_DISPLAY_INFO            Check Whether Valuation Information Can Be Displayed        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I DISPLAY_CALCULATION_INFO      Display of Valuation Information                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I GET_MINIMUM_RESULT            Read Minimum Result for Question or List Item               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I GET_PROPERTIES                Read Various Settings                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_CALCULATE      I GET_SCORE_LABEL               Read Field Description for Calculated Result                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ACTION_AT_SAVE         Change Action When Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ACTION_BEFORE_UPDATE   Change Action Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ACTION_IN_UPDATE       Change Action in the Update Task                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CREATE_ACTION_AT_SAVE         Create Action When Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CREATE_ACTION_BEFORE_UPDATE   Create Action Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I CREATE_ACTION_IN_UPDATE       Create Action in Update Task                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I DELETE_ACTION_AT_SAVE         Delete Action When Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I DELETE_ACTION_BEFORE_UPDATE   Delete Action Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_COR_UPDATE     I DELETE_ACTION_IN_UPDATE       Delete Action in Update Task                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_GOS            I SELECT_SERVICES               Select the Services of Generic Object Services              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_HELP_LINKS     I GET_URL_FOR_MAIN_SCREEN       Getting the URL for Initial Screen                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_HELP_LINKS     I HANDLE_EXTENDED_HELP_REQUEST  Object-Specific Processing of Help Request                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_IDENTIFIER     I GET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Define Display of Audit Component in Navigation Structure   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_IDENTIFIER     I GET_EXTERNAL_ID               Preassign Key When Creating Audit Component                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_IDENTIFIER     I IS_EXTERNAL_ID_CHANGEABLE     Can Key Be Changed ('0' -" Not Changeable)                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LAST_GET       I CHOOSE_LAST_AUDIT             Selection of Relevant Audit from List of Audits             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LAST_GET       I SELECTION_CRITERIONS          Changing the Selection Criteria                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I AFTER_SET_ATTRIBUTES          Call After Transfer of Attributes                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I CHECK                         Check of Attributes                                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I COPY                          Transfer of Attributes When Copying List Items              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execution of a Menu Function                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Passing of Attributes Taking Reference into Account         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Request for Context Menu in Tree                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_CREATE_MENU               Request for Create Menu in Tree                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Request for Display Characteristics                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Transfers Field Properties to a Field                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_IMAGE                     Request for Icon                                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I GET_UI_STRUCTURE              Return of External Structure                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I IMPORT_UI_STRUCTURE_DATA      Conversion of External to Internal Structure                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I ON_DROP                       Object Was Dropped on List Item in Tree                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I PREPARE_OUTPUT                Preparation for Displaying Using Subscreen Call             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_LIST_ITEM_TYPE I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Transfer of Attributes with Checks                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_MONITOR_ALV    I MODIFY_FIELDCAT               Adjust Field Catalog                                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I CHECK                         Consistency Check of Audit Object (-"Error Log)             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I CHECK_SINGLE                  Consistency Check of Audit Object (-"Error Log)             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I DISPLAY                       Display of Audit Object (For Example, Detail Screen)        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I GET_VALUE_SHORT_TEXTS         Read Short Texts for Audit Object                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I MAP_OBJECTS_TO_UI_STRUC       Display Audit Object in Flat Audit-UI-Structure             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I PAI_CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT        Convert User Entry into Internal Format (GUID)              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_OBJECT         I VALUE_HELP                    Input Help Using F4 for the Audit Object                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_CONT     I EXECUTE                       Change of Audit Question                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_CONT     I GET_STARTING_TIME             Returns Start Time of Execution of Procedure                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_CONT     I IS_EXTERNAL_SOURCE            Is controlling object outside current audit?                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_CONT     I IS_USABLE                     Returns Whether Procedure Can Be Used                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_COPY     I ALTER_AUDITQUEST_ATTRIBUTES   Changing the Attributes of the Audit Question List Item     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_COPY     I CHECK_AUDIT                   Check whether a question list can be assigned to the audit  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUEST_COPY     I CHECK_QUESTIONNAIRE           Check whether the question list can be assigned to the audit.
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_HEADER_AT_SAVE         Change Header During Saving                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_HEADER_BEFORE_UPDATE   Change Header Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_HEADER_IN_UPDATE       Change Header in Update Task                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ITEM_AT_SAVE           Change Item During Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ITEM_BEFORE_UPDATE     Change Item Before Calling the Update Task                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CHANGE_ITEM_IN_UPDATE         Change Item in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_HEADER_AT_SAVE         Create Header During Saving                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_HEADER_BEFORE_UPDATE   Create Header Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_HEADER_IN_UPDATE       Create Header in Update Task                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_ITEM_AT_SAVE           Create Item During Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_ITEM_BEFORE_UPDATE     Create Item Before Calling the Update Task                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I CREATE_ITEM_IN_UPDATE         Create Item in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_HEADER_AT_SAVE         Delete Header During Saving                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_HEADER_BEFORE_UPDATE   Delete Header Before Calling the Update Task                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_HEADER_IN_UPDATE       Delete Header in Update Task                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_ITEM_AT_SAVE           Delete Item During Saving                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_ITEM_BEFORE_UPDATE     Delete Item Before Calling the Update Task                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_QUN_UPDATE     I DELETE_ITEM_IN_UPDATE         Delete Item in Update Task                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_ACTIONS               Transfer of Corrective Actions                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_AUDIT                 Transfer of Audits                                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_AUDITEDOBJECT         Transfer of Audit Objects                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_AUDITPLAN             Transfer of Audit Plans                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_AUDITQUEST            Transfer of Audit Questions                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I COLLECT_ROLES                 Transfer of Partners                                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization After Commit Work                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_BW         I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I CHANGE_CREATE_MENU            Change Creation Menu for Audit Component                    .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I COPY_DOCUMENTS                Copies Documents for an Object                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I CREATE_DOCUMENT_WITH_CONTENT  Create Document Assignment Without Dialog                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I CREATE_EXECUTE                Screen for Object Creation                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I GET_DOCUMENTS                 What Documents Are Assigned?                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I GET_ID                        Request Object Identification                               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I ON_COPY_DOCUMENTS             Copies Documents                                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_DOC        I ON_MOVE_DOCUMENTS             Moves Documents and Directories                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I GET_PROGRAM                   Returns Program for Text Management                         .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I GET_TEXT_IDS                  Delivers IDs for Audit Components                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I MAINTAIN                      Compare Data in Long Text Processing                        .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I PROVIDE_DATA                  Make Data Available for Long Text Processing PBO            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I READ_PROC                     Read Texts for Object                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I RESET_UI                      Reset Global Variables in UI                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I SAPSCRIPT_INITIALIZE          Initialization of SAPScript Attributes for Object           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I SAPSCRIPT_PAI                 Read Text Changes for PAI                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SAP_TXT        I TEXT_RESET                    Remove Texts from SAPScript Memory                          .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SEARCHHELP     I GET_VALUES_GROUPING           Read Values for "Grouping"                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SEARCHHELP     I GET_VALUES_SEARCH_FIELD       Read Values for "Search Field"                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SIGNATURE      I DISPLAY_SIGNATURES            Display of Signatures                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_SIGNATURE      I SIGN_AUDIT                    Signing of Audit                                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STATUS         I CHECK_ACTIVITY                Check Whether Execution of Transaction Is Allowed           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STATUS         I GET_PERMITTED_CHANGES         Reading of Permissible Changes                              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STATUS         I GET_UI_DATA                   Reading of Data for the Display                             .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STATUS         I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Determines Whether Master Data Changes are Allowed for Comp..
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STATUS         I IS_USABLE                     Determines Whether a Component Can Be Used                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STRUCTURE      I GET_DATA                      Transfer of Structure                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STRUCTURE      I GET_TYPES                     Return of Possible Structure (Top-Down, Bottom-Up,...       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STRUCTURE      I HANDLE_NODE_EXECUTE           Execution of Menu Option from Context Menu                  .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_STRUCTURE      I HANDLE_NODE_MENU              Return of Context Menu for a Node                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_TEXT_ID        I GET_AUDITQUEST_TRANSFER_ID    Returns the Text IDs for the XML Transfer of Audit Questions.
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_TEXT_ID        I GET_QUESTION_TRANSFER_ID      Returns the Text IDs for the XML Transfer of Questions      .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_TEXT_ID        I GET_TEXT_IDS                  Returns the Text IDs for the Audit Component                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_TYPE           I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execution of a Menu Function                                .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_TYPE           I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Request for Context Menu in Tree                            .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_XML            I ADD_DATA_TO_AUDIT_XML         Add Data to Audit XML                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_XML            I GET_SURVEY_XSLT               Determine XSLT File Name for Survey Generation              .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_XML            I MANIPULATE_XML_EXPORT         Change XML File During Export                               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUDIT_XML            I MANIPULATE_XML_IMPORT         Change XML File During Import                               .
IF_EX_PLM_AUD_AUDIT_ROLES      I COPY_ROLES                    Copy Roles for Corrective Actions                           .
IF_EX_PLM_AUD_AUDIT_ROLES      I GET_DEFAULT_ROLES             Provide Default Roles                                       .
IF_EX_PLM_CATALOG_IF           I CATALOG_GET_ALTERNATIV        Find Catalog ID Using Customer-Internal Logic               .
IF_EX_PLM_CATALOG_IF           I COMPONENT_VIA_CATALOG_GET     Procurement of Components Using Catalog                     .
IF_EX_PLM_CATALOG_IF           I COMPONENT_VIA_CATALOG_MODIFY  Changing the Components from Catalog Selection              .
IF_EX_PLM_CATALOG_IF           I SERVICE_VIA_CATALOG_MODIFY    Change of Service from Catalog Selection                    .
IF_EX_PLM_EXPO_ADDOBJECTS      I EXPO_CHANGE_TAGS              Extend Mapping of Object Types to Tags                      .
IF_EX_PLM_EXPO_ADDOBJECTS      I EXPO_PACKAGE_CREATED          Expo Package Initialized                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_EXPO_ADDOBJECTSI     I EXPO_CHANGE_TAGS              Extend Mapping of Object Types to Tags                      .
IF_EX_PLM_EXPO_ADDOBJECTSI     I EXPO_PACKAGE_CREATED          Expo Package Initialized                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_EXPO_INIT_ECM        I INITIALIZE_ECM                Initialize ECM Processor                                    .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CHANGE_FIELD_LABEL            Change Field Label                                          .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CHANGE_HELP_URL               Change URL of Help Page                                     .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CHANGE_OBJECT_INFO            Change Icons and Icon Text in Tree                          .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CHANGE_OTR_TEXT               Change Language-Dependent Text Element                      .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CHANGE_URL                    Change URL                                                  .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CUSTOMER_EVENT_PROCESS        Handle Customer-Specific Event (Button on View)             .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CUSTOMER_PANEL_EVENT_DEFINE   Define Customer-Specific Category (View)                    .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I CUSTOMER_VIEW_DEFINE          Define Customer-Specific View (Page Fragment frm Controller).
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I DEFAULT_PAGE_INTROTEXT_GET    Define Text on Initial Page (with Hyperlinks...)            .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_ADDITIONAL_INFO        Define HTML for Additional Information Under Header         .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_ALTERNATIVES           Define HTML for Alternatives                                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_ASSIGNMENTS            Define HTML for Dependencies                                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_CHANGE_NUMBER          Define HTML for Change Number Detail                        .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_CMPN_DATASHEET         Define HTML for Structure Node Attributes                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_CMPN_VARIANTS          Define HTML for Variant Overview for Structure Node         .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_CMPV_CONCEPTS          Define HTML for Concept Overview for Structure Node         .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_CMPV_DATASHEET         Define HTML for Variant Attributes (Structure)              .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_DOCUMENTS              Define HTML for Document Overview for Object                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_DOCUMENT_BOM           Define HTML for Document Structure (Document Detail)        .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_DOCUMENT_HEADER        Define HTML for Document Header Data                        .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_DOC_DATASHEET          Define HTML for Document Attributes (Detail)                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_DOC_FILES              Define HTML for Originals for Document Info Record          .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_GENN_DATASHEET         Define HTML for Detail Attributes for Engineering Node      .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_MAIL                   Define HTML for Page Fragment for Sending Mail              .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_MESSAGES               Define HTML for Message Output                              .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_NAVIGATION_PATH        Define HTML for Navigation History                          .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_OBJECT_HEADER          Define HTML for Header Data for iPPE Object                 .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_PCLASS                 Define HTML for Detail Screen for Class                     .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_PLM_MASTERDATA         Define HTML for Detail Screen for PLM Object (Material...)  .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_SEARCH_RESULT          Define HTML for Search Result (Initial Page)                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STATUS_DETAIL          Define HTML for Status Detail                               .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STATUS_DET_PRECOND     Define HTML for Status Detail: Preconditions                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STATUS_DET_PRED        Define HTML for Status Detail: Previous Status              .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STATUS_OVV             Define HTML for Status Overview for Object                  .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STRUCTURE_TAB_CHILDREN Define HTML for Directly Subordinate Nodes                  .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STRUCTURE_TAB_FATHERS  Define HTML for Directly Superior Nodes                     .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_STRUCTURE_UPWARD_PATH  Define HTML for Upward Path                                 .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_WORKFLOW_CHOOSE        Define HTML for Selectable Workflows to Start               .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_WORKFLOW_INBOX         Define HTML for Workflow Inbox                              .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_WORKFLOW_TAB           Define HTML for Workflow Table for Object                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I LAYOUT_WORKITEM_DETAIL        Define HTML for Workflow Detail                             .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I PROCESS_REQUEST               On Input Processing for http Request                        .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I USER_SETTINGS_CHANGE          Change Default User Settings                                .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOWS_GET_FOR_START_DOC   Read Startable Workflows for Document                       .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOWS_GET_FOR_START_NODE  Read Startable Workflows for iPPE Node                      .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOWS_GET_FOR_START_VAR   Read Startable Workflows for iPPE Variant                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOWS_LOAD_TO_OBJECT      Read Workflows for Object                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOW_INBOX_LOAD           Read Work Items for Inbox                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PDN_WUI              I WORKFLOW_STARTPAGE_DEFINE     Define URL for Workflow Start                               .
IF_EX_PLM_PS_ADDTL_TRANS       I ADD_TRANSACTION               Additional Transaction                                      .
IF_EX_PLM_PS_CUST_TRANS        I EXECUTE_TRANSACTION           Customer Transaction Call                                   .
IF_EX_PLM_PS_MYCPROJECTS       I SELECT_OBJECTS                User-Depend. Selection of MyProjects Instead of My Favorites.
IF_EX_PLM_PS_TRANS_TYPE        I DETERMINE_TRANS_TYPE          Determine Transaction Type                                  .
IF_EX_PL_PACKINST_DET_BADI     I FILL_KOMGP_PACKING_DIALOG     Pckg Instr. Det. in Pack Transtn: Fill KOMGP With Own Values.
IF_EX_PL_PACKINST_DIALOG       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport of Packing Instr. from Cust.-Specific Screen .
IF_EX_PL_PACKINST_DIALOG       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport of Pcking Instr. to Cust.-Specific Screen    .
IF_EX_PL_PACK_INSTR_BADI       I PACK_INSTR_BEFORE_SAVE        Access to Current Packing Instruction Data to Save          .
IF_EX_PL_PACK_INSTR_BADI       I PACK_INSTR_BEFORE_UNDELETE    Access to Packing Instruction That Should Be Reactivated    .
IF_EX_PL_PACK_INSTR_BADI       I PACK_INSTR_CHECK              Access to Current Packing Instruction Data to Check         .
IF_EX_PL_PACK_INSTR_BADI       I PACK_INSTR_READ               Access to Current Packing Instruction Data to Read          .
IF_EX_PL_PRESEL_HU_DLVRY       I CHECK_ROOTS_FOR_DLVY_CREATE   Check of HUs for Delivery Creation                          .
IF_EX_PL_PRESEL_HU_DLVRY       I PRESELECT_HU_FOR_DLVY         Assignment of HUs to Deliveries in Transport                .
IF_EX_PMMN0001                 I MODIFY_REQUIREMENTS           Modification of Calculated Requirement                      .
IF_EX_PMOD46C_STATUS_LIST      I MODIFY_LIST                   Modify Status List                                          .
IF_EX_PMOD46C_VARIANS_LIST     I MODIFY_LIST                   Modify Variant List                                         .
IF_EX_PMOD46C_VARIANT_LIST     I MODIFY_LIST                   Modify Variant List                                         .
IF_EX_PMPS_ORDER_SAVE          I OVERWRITE_CURRENT_VALUES      Overwrites the current project assignment with a new        .
IF_EX_PMPS_ORDER_SAVE          I WBS_INHERIT_DEFAULT           Default WBS Inheritance to Order from Network               .
IF_EX_PMPS_SELSCREENS          I SET_VARIANT_DEFAULTS          Set default variants for PM/PS selection screens            .
IF_EX_PMRE_MCB_RETRACT         I DATA_PROCESS                  Processing Data Submitted for Retraction                    .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_ACCESS         I ACCESS_DATA_PREP              Enhance Portfolio Determination Data                        .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_ACCESS         I FILTER_HIERARCHY_DATA         Filter Data in Hierarchy Access                             .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_CHANGE         I CHECK_DATA                    Customer-Specific Data Check                                .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_CHANGE         I GET_DATA                      Adopt Data                                                  .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_CHANGE         I GET_SCREEN                    Adopt Screen                                                .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_CHANGE         I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_PORTFOLIO_CHANGE         I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_POST_ACTION_ACL          I ON_SAVE_APPL_OBJ              On save of application objects of specific type             .
IF_EX_POS_EX_CAS               I CALL                          Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_POS_EX_CAS_A_F           I CALL                          Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_POS_EX_REC               I CALL                          Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_POS_EX_REC_A_F           I CALL                          Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_POS_HPR_PRESTEP          I CALL                          Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_POS_WPUBON_MB_CREATE     I CHANGE_DATA                   Manipulate Data Before Posting                              .
IF_EX_POS_WPUBON_MB_POST       I SAVE_POS_EVENT                Save POS Operation for Physical Inventory                   .
IF_EX_POS_WPUUMS_MB_CREATE     I CHANGE_DATA                   Manipulate Data Before Posting                              .
IF_EX_PPA_CUST_BADI            I CHECK_DOCUMENT_TYPE           Check document type                                         .
IF_EX_PPA_CUST_BADI            I MESSAGE_HANDLING              Message handling for Improper Invoice Functionality         .
IF_EX_PPA_CUST_BADI            I UPDATE_PUSHBUTTON_TEXT        Update Pushbutton Text on Subscreen                         .
IF_EX_PPC_CONFIRMATION         I CONFIRMATION_DATA             Provision of Backflush Data in DB Table Form                .
IF_EX_PPC_CONFIRMATION         I PROCESSED_CONFIRMATION        Processed Backflushes                                       .
IF_EX_PPC_CONFIRM_INSERT       I CONFIRMATION_DATA             Provision of Backflush Data in DB Table Form                .
IF_EX_PPC_RESERV_DISTRIB       I FORWARD_REPROCESSING          Create/Change/Delete Postprocessing Records in APO          .
IF_EX_PPEGIFCAT                I FCAT_DISP_SETTINGS            Defines Settings for Displaying the Field Catalog           .
IF_EX_PPEGIFCAT                I FIELDCAT_FILL                 Fills the Extension of the Field Catalog                    .
IF_EX_PPEGIFCAT                I TREE_SHOW_MATERIALS           Specifies if materials are to be displayed                  .
IF_EX_PPEGI_CTMENU             I MENU_REQUEST                  Extend Menu                                                 .
IF_EX_PPEGI_CTMENU             I MENU_SELECT                   Intercept Menu Item                                         .
IF_EX_PPELISCMPV               I PRECOND_CHECK                 Additional Checks for Maintenance of Preconditions          .
IF_EX_PPELISCMPV               I STATUS_CHECK                  Additional Checks for Maintenance of Status                 .
IF_EX_PPELISCMPV               I STATUS_CREATE                 Detailed Values when Creating Status                        .
IF_EX_PPELISGENN               I PRECOND_CHECK                 Additional Checks for Maintenance of Preconditions          .
IF_EX_PPELISGENN               I STATUS_CHECK                  Additional Checks for Maintenance of Status                 .
IF_EX_PPELISGENN               I STATUS_CREATE                 Detailed Values when Creating Status                        .
IF_EX_PPETICMP_FCAT            I SET_COLUMN_CAPTIONS           Adjust Column Headings for Each Individual Tree             .
IF_EX_PPETICMP_FCAT            I SET_COLUMN_GROUPS             Group Related Columns                                       .
IF_EX_PPETICMP_FCAT            I SET_EDITABLE_FIELDS_PNOD      Set Ready for Input Status of Fields for Node               .
IF_EX_PPETICMP_FCAT            I SET_EDITABLE_FIELDS_POSV      Set Ready for Input Status of Fields for Variant            .
IF_EX_PPETICMP_FCAT            I SET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Set Field Attributes for Fields of the Field Catalog        .
IF_EX_PPEUISET_DISPLAY         I SET_DISPLAY                   Display the Set Assignment                                  .
IF_EX_PPLAN_GET_DETAILS        I ADD_INFOS                     Additional Information for Payment Plan Items               .
IF_EX_PPLAN_SET_CUST_DATA      I SET_DATA                      Set Customer Fields (CI_ISCD)                               .
IF_EX_PRA_RV_UOM_EXTRACT       I UOM_EXTRACT                   UOM extraction                                              .
IF_EX_PRC_CUST_CHECKS          I CHECK_KALSM                   Check all Rows for Pricing Procedure                        .
IF_EX_PRC_CUST_CHECKS          I CHECK_KSCHL                   Check Condition Type                                        .
IF_EX_PRC_CUST_CHECKS          I CHECK_MAX_SCALE_DIM           Check Maximum Number of Scale Dimensions                    .
IF_EX_PRC_CUST_CHECKS          I GENERAL_SETTINGS              Make General Settings                                       .
IF_EX_PRC_DATA_SOURCES         I DETERMINE_ATTRIBUTES          Determine Relevant Attributes                               .
IF_EX_PRC_DATA_SOURCES         I GET_DATA                      Data Collection                                             .
IF_EX_PRC_PRICING_INIT         I GET_PRICING_PARAMETERS        Determinse Controlling Partner for Pricing Call             .
IF_EX_PRC_ROUNDING_RULE        I EXECUTE                       Execute the Rounding Rule                                   .
IF_EX_PRICAT_IN_CHANGE         I INBOUND_CHANGE                Method for Changing IDoc Inbox                              .
IF_EX_PRICAT_IN_EXTIN          I CHECK_INBOUND_EXTENSIONIN     BAPI_PRICECATALOGUE_SAVREPLICA, Check Parameter             .
IF_EX_PRICAT_IN_EXTIN          I UPDATE_INBOUND_EXTENSIONIN    BAPI_CATALOGUE_SAVREPLICA, UPDATE Customer-Specific         .
IF_EX_PRICAT_OUT_EXTIN         I OUTBOUND_EXTENSIONIN          BAPI_PRICECATALOGUE_SAVREPLICA, User Parameter              .
IF_EX_PRICAT_OUT_EXTIN         I PRICAT_OUT_K010               BAPI_PRICECATALOGUE_SAVREPLICA, Ext. Generic Fields         .
IF_EX_PRICE_POINT_GROUPS       I ASSIGNMENTTYPE_DETERMINE      Determine Assgmt Type (Mater. Hier./Mat.Group/Dist.Ch./PL)  .
IF_EX_PRICE_POINT_GROUPS       I POPUP_CHANGE_EPRGXFIELDS      Mass Change Price Point List Field (Mater. Hier./Mat.Group) .
IF_EX_PRICE_POINT_GROUPS       I POPUP_CHANGE_PRICEFIELDS_HI   Price Mass Change with Price Point Grp to Mater. Hierarchy  .
IF_EX_PRICE_POINT_GROUPS       I PRICEPOINTGROUP_DETERM_HIER   Determine Price Point Group from the Material Hierachy      .
IF_EX_PRICHANGEMANAGEMENT      I SET_CHANGES                   Set Changes                                                 .
IF_EX_PRICHECKPOSITION         I CHECK_BOM                     Check BOM                                                   .
IF_EX_PRICHECKPOSITION         I CHECK_CUSTOMER_PRICE          Check a Price for a Customer                                .
IF_EX_PRICHECKPOSITION         I CHECK_CUSTOMER_PRICES_ALL     Check all Prices for an Item                                .
IF_EX_PRICHECKPOSITION         I CHECK_POSITION                Check an Item                                               .
IF_EX_PRICHECKPOSITION         I CHECK_POSITION_CUST           Check Catalog Item, Adjust Shipment Indicator if Necessary  .
IF_EX_PRICING_ITEM_COPY        I FILL                          Expand Main Conditions                                      .
IF_EX_PRICING_ITEM_COPY        I PRICING_DATA_EXCHANGE         Data Transfer After Calling PRICING Module                  .
IF_EX_PRINTER_DETERM_PPF       I GET_PRINTER_DATA              Delivers the Printer                                        .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_BOM                      Read BOMs                                                   .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_BOM_COMPONENTS           Read BOM Components                                         .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_CONDITION                Read Prices                                                 .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_CONDITION_COMPLETE       Read Prices, Enhanced Interfaces                            .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_MATERIAL                 Read Material Data                                          .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_MATERIAL_CHANGES         Read Planned Changes                                        .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_MODULE_MATERIALS         Read Materials for Each Asssortment Module                  .
IF_EX_PRIREADMATERIAL          I READ_UNIT                     Reading of Units of Measure                                 .
IF_EX_PRISETPARTNER            I ADJUST_K00C                   Enhance, Change Fields in K00C for each Customer            .
IF_EX_PRISETPARTNER            I SET_PARTNER_PARMS             Set Parameters for Reading EDI/ALE Partners                 .
IF_EX_PROCESS_MESS_EVT         I AFTER_MESSAGE_SENT            Handling of Receiver Errors After Sending Message           .
IF_EX_PROCESS_MESS_SEL_PMA     I SELECT_PROCESS_MESSAGE        Process Message Selection                                   .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_API_UPD          I API_UPDATE                    Updating API Structure by New Set Type                      .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ARCHIVE          I ARCHIVE_EXTRA_DATA            Archive Additional Data (Not Created in Set Types)          .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ARCHIVE          I CHECK_ARCHIVABLE              Usage Check: Can Products Be Archived and Deleted?          .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ARCHIVE          I EXPAND_EXTRA_STRUCTURE        Extend Archive Structure By Additional Data Elements        .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ARCHIVE          I RELOAD_EXTRA_DATA             Read Additional Data (Not Created in Set Types) from Archive.
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ARCHIVE          I VERIFY_EXTRA_DATA             Check Additional Data (Not Created in Set Types)            .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_EXTRACT          I EXTRACT_LONGTEXTS             Extraction of Long Texts                                    .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_GET_DETAIL       I GET_LONGTEXT                  Reading Product Long Texts                                  .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_GET_HISTORY      I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTE_HISTORY      Change History at Attribute Level                           .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_GTIN_CONVERT     I GTIN_CONVERT_TO_DB_FORMAT     Conversion from I/O Format to DB Format                     .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_GTIN_CONVERT     I GTIN_CONVERT_TO_IO_FORMAT     Conversion from DB Format to I/O Format                     .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ID_INPUT_EXT     I PRODUCT_ID_CHANGE             Predefined Product ID Is Being Changed                      .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_ID_INPUT_INT     I PRODUCT_GET_ID                Internal Assignment of a Product ID                         .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_SET              I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Checks Dependent on Set Type, Before Saving                 .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_SET              I VALUE_HELP                    F4 Help for Product Attributes                              .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_SETTYPE_UPD      I BLUEPRINT_UPDATE              Updating Set Type Blueprint Entries                         .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_SETTYPE_UPD      I CHECK                         Updating Set Type Blueprint Entries                         .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_SETTYPE_UPD      I SETTYPE_UPDATE                Updating Set Type                                           .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_UOM              I PRODUCT_UOM_CONVERSION_CHANGEDConversion Factors/Units of Measure Have Been Changed in UI .
IF_EX_PRODUCT_UOM              I PRODUCT_UOM_DELETED           Product Unit of Measure Has Been Deleted                    .
IF_EX_PROD_SETTYPE_TRANS       I ADD_OBJECTS_TO_TRANSPORT      Include Additional Objects in Transport Request             .
IF_EX_PROJECTDEF_UPDATE        I AT_SAVE                       Save Project Definition, Time: Dialog                       .
IF_EX_PROJECTDEF_UPDATE        I BEFORE_UPDATE                 ave Project Definition, Time: Before Update                 .
IF_EX_PRO_SETTYPE_UI           I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport of Data from Subscreen                            .
IF_EX_PRO_SETTYPE_UI           I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport of Data to Subscreen                              .
IF_EX_PR_DS_GEN_APPLID_IL      I DETERMINE_APPL_ID             Determining Applications for Generation                     .
IF_EX_PR_DS_GEN_APPLID_SET     I DETERMINE_APPL_ID             Determining Applications for Generation                     .
IF_EX_PSCM_PARTNER             I MODIFY_CONTRACT_ACCOUNT_FIELDSObsolete: Modify contract account fields                    .
IF_EX_PSCM_PARTNER             I MODIFY_CONTRACT_OBJECT_FIELDS Obsolete: Modify contract object fields                     .
IF_EX_PSCM_PARTNER             I SELECT_STANDARD_ADDRESS       Obsolete: Select subtype of 1028 as the standard address    .
IF_EX_PSCM_PARTNER             I SET_CUSTOMER_BP_NUMBER        Determine business partner number (from student number)     .
IF_EX_PSCM_PARTNER             I SET_CUSTOMER_STUDENT_NUMBER   Determine student number (from business partner number)     .
IF_EX_PS_PLANNING_PERIODS      I CHANGE_PLANNING_PERIODS       Change Evaluation and Planning Periods                      .
IF_EX_PS_SUMM_KAP2001          I EXIT_SAPLKAP2_001             Transfer of Additional Fields from Table PSMERK             .
IF_EX_PS_TRANSFER_DATES        I AT_BASIC_TO_FORECAST          Transfer Dates for WBS Without Network                      .
IF_EX_PS_TRANSFER_DATES        I AT_FORECAST_TO_BASIC          Transfer Dates for WBS Without Network                      .
IF_EX_PTCCE_DIST_DATA          I DISTRIBUTE_DAILY_BALANCE      Distribution of Day Balances                                .
IF_EX_PTCCE_DIST_DATA          I DISTRIBUTE_PERIOD_BALANCE     Distribution of Period Balances                             .
IF_EX_PTCCE_DIST_DATA          I DISTRIBUTE_QUOTA              Distribution of Time Quota Status                           .
IF_EX_PTCCE_DIST_DATA          I DISTRIBUTE_WAGETYPE           Distribution of Wage Type                                   .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_ATT_COUNTRY       I CALCULATE_COUNTRY             Calculation of payroll days and hours                       .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I CHECK_TIME_CONSTRAINTS        Check Dates of Request                                      .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I CHECK_TIME_CONSTR_FOR_SUBTY   Check Request Date According to Subtype                     .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I GET_FIELD_SELECTION_ATTRIBS   Gets Customizing for Field Selection                        .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I GET_IT0005_QUOTAS             Gets Time Accounts from Infotype 0005                       .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I GET_MOD_AND_QTYPE             Determines MOD and QTYPE for Func.Module HR_GET_QUOTA_DATA  .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I GET_TIMETYPES_AS_QUOTAS       Determine Time Types as Time Accounts                       .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I GET_WORKFLOW_ATTRIBS          Gets Customizing for Workflow                               .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I POST_VIA_BLOP                 Post Attendances/Absences with BLoP                         .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I SET_CALENDAR_COLOR            Adjust Colors of Calendar and Team Calendar                 .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I SET_CALENDAR_LEGEND_COLORS    Adjust Legend for Calendar and Team Calendar                .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I SET_CALENDAR_OVERLAPPING_COLORAdjust Color for Overlapping Absences                       .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I SET_OVERVIEW_LEGEND_COLORS    Adjust Legend for Availability Overview                     .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I SIMULATE_VIA_BLOP             Simulate Attendances/Absences with BLoP                     .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I TEAM_CALE_ENRICHMENT          Enrich Team Calendar (Rows + Texts)                         .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ               I VALIDATE_AND_SIMULATE         Validate and Simulate Attendances/Absences with BLoP        .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_T554S_WEB                 Read Customizing Settings Dependent on Absence Type         .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_T556A_WEB                 OBSOLETE: Read Absence Quota Customizing                    .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_T556P_WEB                 OBSOLETE: Read Attendance Quota Customizing                 .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_T559D_WEB                 OBSOLETE: Read Quota Customizing                            .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_WEB_ABS_REQ               OBSOLETE: Read General Settings for Leave Request           .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_WEB_GROUP_ID              OBSOLETE: Read Groupings for Customizing Tables             .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_WEB_RULE_GROUP            OBSOLETE: Read Rule Group for Customizing Tables            .
IF_EX_PT_ABS_REQ_CUST          I GET_WEB_TRANS_MESS            OBSOLETE: Read Reworked Error Text                          .
IF_EX_PT_BLP_RET_MESS          I SET_DATA                      Parameter Determination                                     .
IF_EX_PT_BLP_USER              I PROCESS_DATA                  Process Time Data                                           .
IF_EX_PT_COR_REQ               I CHECK_TIME_CONSTRAINTS        Check Dates of Request                                      .
IF_EX_PT_COR_REQ               I POST_VIA_BLOP                 Post Clock-In/Out Corrections with BLP                      .
IF_EX_PT_COR_REQ               I SIMULATE_VIA_BLOP             Simulate Clock-In/Out Corrections with BLP                  .
IF_EX_PT_EV_INFTY_COUNTRY      I GET_PSOPER                    Get Changed Infotype Records                                .
IF_EX_PT_EV_INFTY_COUNTRY      I INIT_PSOPER                   Initialize Changed Infotype Records                         .
IF_EX_PT_EV_INFTY_COUNTRY      I UPDATE_PSOPER                 Update Changed Infotype Records                             .
IF_EX_PT_FMLA                  I CALCULATE_ELIGIBILITY_HRS     Calculate Eligibility Hours                                 .
IF_EX_PT_FMLA                  I CALCULATE_WEEK_CONVERTER      Calculate Week Converter                                    .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I CHECK_IF_ACTOR_ABSENT         Check Whether an Employee Is Absent                         .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I CHECK_SELECTED_NEXT_PROCESSOR Check Selected Agent                                        .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I FILTER_NEXT_PROCESSOR         Filter Next Agent                                           .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I FIND_RESP_AND_DEFAULT_NEXT_PRCDetermine Default Approver and Supervisor for Employee      .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I GET_ACTOR_SUBSTITUTES         Read Substitute                                             .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I GET_ADMINS                    Get Table with E-Mail Lists                                 .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I GET_EMPLOYEE_COMMUNICATION    Determine E-Mail Address                                    .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I MODIFY_APPLICATION_MESSAGES   Change Messages from Back-End System                        .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I SEARCH_FOR_NEXT_PROCESSOR     Find Next Agent                                             .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ               I START_WF                      Start Workflow                                              .
IF_EX_PT_GEN_REQ_INTERN        I PROVIDE_TRANSITION_STATE_INFO Returns Information for Status Transfer                     .
IF_EX_PT_GUI_TMW_CALENDAR      I GET_VALUES                    Get List of Selection Periods                               .
IF_EX_PT_GUI_TMW_TDE_NM        I FILL_CUSTOMER_CELLS           Fill Customer Fields                                        .
IF_EX_PT_IAC_LEAVREQ_0001      I MODIFY_ATTABS_LIST            Modified List of Attendance and Absence Types Determined    .
IF_EX_PT_IAC_REPORT            I GET_VARIANT                   Define Variant                                              .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I CALCULATE_ACCRUAL_ENTITLEMENT Calculation of accrual entitlement                          .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I CALCULATE_BASE_ENTITLEMENT    Calculation of Base Entitlement                             .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I CHECK_RULE_APPLICABILITY      Check Applicability of Generation Rule                      .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I DETERMINE_HIRE_FIRE_DATE      Determine Entry/Finish Dates                                .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I DETERMINE_PERIOD              Determine Accrual/Base Period                               .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I REDUCE_ACCRUAL_ENTITLEMENT    Reduction of Accrual Entitlement                            .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA                 I SUPPLY_MISSING_REV_ATTRIBUTES Missing Generation Attributes for Quota Corrections         .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA_DEDUCTION       I CALCULATE_QUOTA               Recalculation of Quota Entitlement                          .
IF_EX_PT_QUOTA_DEF_VAL         I SET_SWITCH                    Determine quota_def_val                                     .
IF_EX_QB_PLAN_SELECTION_P      I PLAN_SELECTION_CHANGE         Change of Selection Parameters for Plan Search in QP07      .
IF_EX_QB_QM_SYSTEM_COMPARE     I QM_SYSTEM_CHANGE              Change Requested and Available QM System                    .
IF_EX_QB_Q_INFO_RECORD         I Q_INFO_KEY_CHANGE             Change Key of Q-Info.Record                                 .
IF_EX_QC_PROFILE_MAINTAIN      I CHARACT_SCREEN_GET_DATA       Retrieve Data                                               .
IF_EX_QC_PROFILE_MAINTAIN      I CHARACT_SCREEN_PUT_DATA       Transfer data                                               .
IF_EX_QC_PROFILE_MAINTAIN      I NEW_CHARACTERISTICS           Changing of Cert. Profile Characteristic During Inclusion   .
IF_EX_QC_QMOCERT_CREATE        I EXIT_BATCH_LIST_EXPLODE       Change of Control Structure for Batch Where-Used List       .
IF_EX_QEC_MAPPING              I MAPPING                       Link of Source and Target Char. with Data Transfer          .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I COPY_LOG_SHOW                 Display of the Copy Logs                                    .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I FCODE_DEACTIVATE_QA           Deactivation of Function Codes at Insp. Lot Processing QA02 .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I FCODE_DEACTIVATE_QE           Deactivation of Function Codes at Results Recording         .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I LOT_MAINTENANCE_COPY          Copy Inspection Results from Insp. Lot Processing QA02      .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I RESULT_RECORDING_COPY         Copy Inspection Results in Results Recording                .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I SAMPLE_CALCULATION_COPY       Copy Inspection Results at Sample Calculation in Insp. Lot  .
IF_EX_QEC_RESULT_COPY          I SAMPLE_CALCULATION_INIT       Initialization of Update Tables                             .
IF_EX_QEC_SELECTION            I INSPECTION_LOT_CHANGE         Changing of Insp. Lot Record at Insp. Lot Processing        .
IF_EX_QEC_SELECTION            I SELECTION                     Selection of Inspection Results (Data Source)               .
IF_EX_QEC_SELECTION            I SETTINGS_CHANGE               Change Settings for Copy Inspection Results Function        .
IF_EX_QEEM_OPER_ADDON          I PERFORM_FCODE                 OK Code Handling for Functional Enhancements for Operation  .
IF_EX_QEEM_OPER_ADDON          I SET_OPER_ICON                 Symbol for Functional Enhancements for Operation            .
IF_EX_QEEM_SUBSCREEN_5000      I GET_DATA                      Retrieve Data from Global Attributes                        .
IF_EX_QEEM_SUBSCREEN_5000      I PROCESS_OK_CODE               OK Code Processing for Subscreen                            .
IF_EX_QEEM_SUBSCREEN_5000      I PUT_DATA                      Transfer Data to Global Attributes                          .
IF_EX_QEVA_ADDON_TAB           I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_QEVA_ADDON_TAB           I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Data in Subscreen Container Transferred to Global Attributes.
IF_EX_QEVA_ADDON_TAB           I SET_TAB_TITLES                Determine Titles of Tab Pages                               .
IF_EX_QEVA_ALT_QTY_INPUT       I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Control of Show/Hide of the Input Help Symbol               .
IF_EX_QEVA_ALT_QTY_INPUT       I PROCESS_QUANTITY              Processing of Quantity (Using Input Help)                   .
IF_EX_QEVA_ALT_QTY_INPUT       I PUT_DATA_AT_PBO               Transfer of Filter Value from Calling Program to BAdI       .
IF_EX_QEVA_OPER_OC             I GET_DATA_PBO                  Get Data from BAdI Screen                                   .
IF_EX_QEVA_OPER_OC             I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data from Subscreen Container to BAdI              .
IF_EX_QEVA_SUBSCREEN_1101      I GET_DATA                      Retrieve Data from Global Attributes                        .
IF_EX_QEVA_SUBSCREEN_1101      I PROCESS_OK_CODE               OK Code Processing for Subscreen                            .
IF_EX_QEVA_SUBSCREEN_1101      I PUT_DATA                      Transfer Data to Global Attributes                          .
IF_EX_QE_RESULT_VALUATION      I RESULT_VALUATION              Valuation of Single Values                                  .
IF_EX_QE_RESULT_VALUATION      I RESULT_VALUATION_MEAN         Valuation of Mean Values                                    .
IF_EX_QE_SAVE                  I IS_ACTIVE                     Checks if BAdI is Active                                    .
IF_EX_QE_SAVE                  I TABLES_IN_OPERATION           Tables/Structures for Operation                             .
IF_EX_QE_SAVE_ADDON            I SAVE_DATA_FOR_OPERATION       Save Tables/Structures for Operation                        .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I EXPORT                        Export Data                                                 .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I GET_DATAINSTANCE              Create Instance of a Data Class                             .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I GET_RELATIONSHIP              Relationships Between Structures                            .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I GET_SELECTIONS                Return All Possible Selections                              .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I GET_STRUCTURE_INFO            Returns Information About Structure Elements                .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I GET_TREESTRUC                 Return DDIC Structure for Tree for Characteristics          .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_MANAGER          I SELECT                        Data Selection                                              .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_VIEWTYP          I CHECK_USABLE                  The view type can be used in the UI                         .
IF_EX_QG_EVAL_VIEWTYP          I VIEW_CREATE                   Generation of a View                                        .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I AFTER_CLOSE_FORM              Printout of Results: Return Values of Module CLOSE_FORM     .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I AFTER_CLOSE_FORM_PA           Inspection Instruction: Return Values of Module CLOSE_FORM  .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I AFTER_CLOSE_FORM_PZ           Sample-Drawing Instructn: Return Values of Module CLOSE_FORM.
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I BEFORE_OPEN_FORM              Printout of Results: Call Parameter of Module OPEN_FORM     .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I BEFORE_OPEN_FORM_PA           Inspection Instruction: Call Parameter of Module OPEN_FORM  .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I BEFORE_OPEN_FORM_PZ           Sample-Drawing Instructn: Call Parameter of Module OPEN_FORM.
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I SELECTION_SCREEN              Printout of Results: Output of Output Device on Sel. Screen .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I SET_CONTEXT                   Printout of Results: Copy of the Inspection Lot Numbers     .
IF_EX_QG_INSP_RESULT_PRINT     I SET_CONTEXT_PA                Insp., Sample-Drawing Instr.: Transfer Insp. Lot, Operation .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I INT_SERVICE_REQUEST_CHECK     Interne Service Anforderung: Check                          .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I INT_SERVICE_REQUEST_INIT      Interne Service Anforderung: Initialize                     .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I POST_NOTIF_POSITION           Determine Data for Notification Item                        .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I REVERSE_NOTIF_EXTERNAL        Delete External Data Separately When Notification is Cancled.
IF_EX_QISR1                    I SCENARIO_AFTER_SUBMIT         Internal Service Request: Exit After Submit Event           .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I SCENARIO_FINAL_BEFORE_SUBMIT  Internal Service Request: Check Before Submit Event         .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I SCENARIO_PROCESS_USER_COMMAND Scenario: Process Own User Commands                         .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I SCENARIO_SET_ADDITIONAL_VALUESScenario: Set Additional Values for F4 Help, and so on      .
IF_EX_QISR1                    I SCENARIO_SET_FORM_VIEW        Scenario: Determine Form View                               .
IF_EX_QISR2                    I ISR_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENT_GET    Interne Service Request: Determine Account Assignment Object.
IF_EX_QISR3                    I CONTAINER_FOR_ACTOR_DET_FILL  Fill Container to Find Processor                            .
IF_EX_QISR4                    I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execution of a Function in the Action Box                   .
IF_EX_QISR5                    I DETERMINE_APPROVER            Determination of Approver                                   .
IF_EX_QISR5                    I DETERMINE_PROCESSOR           Determination of Processor                                  .
IF_EX_QISR6                    I SCENARIO_CHANGE               Exchange of Scenario                                        .
IF_EX_QISR6                    I SCENARIO_CHECK                Scenario Check                                              .
IF_EX_QM00_SUBSCR_5000         I GET_DATA_PAI                  Retrieve Data in Subscreen Container from Global Data       .
IF_EX_QM00_SUBSCR_5000         I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_QM00_SUBSCR_5000         I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Data in Called Screen to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_QM00_SUBSCR_5000         I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data in Subscreen Container to Global Attributes   .
IF_EX_QM11_NODE_ATTRIBUTE      I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Change Object Attribute for Node Labeling in Document Flow  .
IF_EX_QM_IDI_INSPPOINT         I INSPPOINT_LIST_CHANGE         Changes the List of Inspection Points Returned              .
IF_EX_QM_INPUT_PROCEDURE       I DISPLAY_DOCU                  Display Implementation Documentation                        .
IF_EX_QM_INPUT_PROCEDURE       I INPUT_PROCEDURE               Perform Input Processing                                    .
IF_EX_QM_MS_OBJECT_NAME        I GET_OBJECT_NAME               Change/Get Name/Text of Object                              .
IF_EX_QM_QCERT_MS              I CHECK_CHAR_RELEVANCE          Check Relevance of Characteristic in Certificate            .
IF_EX_QM_QCERT_MS              I FILL_KOMI                     New Fields for Certificate Profile Determination            .
IF_EX_QM_QCERT_MS              I SEARCH_MS_OBJECTS             Specification Search Relevant for Document Data             .
IF_EX_QM_VALUATE_MS            I GET_OBJECT_VALUATION          Change of Valuation (Traffic Light) for Objects             .
IF_EX_QM_VALUATE_MS            I GET_VALUATION_PROPOSAL        Change Default Value for Objects                            .
IF_EX_QPAP_FLEX_PLAN           I PLMKB_QAPO_MODIFY             Method to Select and Modify the Specifications              .
IF_EX_QPL1_CHG_QALS_WA         I CHANGE_QALS_WA                Change of the QALS Work Area in the Add-On                  .
IF_EX_QPL1_QTYUPD_CHECK        I CHECK_QTY_UPD                 Inspection at Correction of Actual Lot Quantity             .
IF_EX_QPL1_SUBSCREEN_ADDON     I GET_DATA_PAI                  Retrieve Data in Subscreen Container from Global Data       .
IF_EX_QPL1_SUBSCREEN_ADDON     I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_QPL1_SUBSCREEN_ADDON     I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Data in Called Screen to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_QPL1_SUBSCREEN_ADDON     I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data in Subscreen Container to Global Attributes   .
IF_EX_QPL1_UPDATE_MHIO         I MHIO_UPDATE                   Confirmation to Scheduling in Case of Cancellation Before UD.
IF_EX_QPLEXT_LOT_CHANGE        I MAP_EXT_TO_INT                Transfer of Individual External Fields                      .
IF_EX_QPLEXT_LOT_CREATE        I MAP_EXT_TO_INT                Transfer of Individual External Fields                      .
IF_EX_QPLEXT_LOT_DECISION      I MAP_INT_TO_EXT                Transfer of Internal Fields                                 .
IF_EX_QPLEXT_PROCESS           I CHECK_MANDATORY_FIELDS        Check Obligatory Fields                                     .
IF_EX_QPRE_CREATE_EXT_SAMP     I CREATE_SAMPLETAB              Read External Sample Data                                   .
IF_EX_QPRE_CREATE_EXT_SAMP     I GET_OPERATIONS                Read Existing Inspection Operations                         .
IF_EX_QPRE_GET_STABI_PHYNR     I GET_STABI_PHYNR               Determine Physical Sample for Lot Creation                  .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADDON_TAB           I GET_DATA_PAI                  Retrieve Data in Subscreen Container from Global Data       .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADDON_TAB           I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADDON_TAB           I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Data in Called Screen to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADDON_TAB           I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data in Subscreen Container to Global Attributes   .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADDON_TAB           I SET_TABTEXT                   Label Pushbutton of Tab Page                                .
IF_EX_QPRS_ADD_CHECK           I TA_CHECK                      Checks if Transaction is Allowed                            .
IF_EX_QPRS_CUST_UPD            I UPDATE_QPRS_CUST              Copy Changes to Customer-Specific Fields in QPR7            .
IF_EX_QST02_STABILOT_WA        I CHANGE_QALS_WA                Change in Inspection Lot Work Area                          .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_BOM_ITEMS               Header Data Manipulation After BOM Determination/Explosion  .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_BOM_ROUT_CHECK          Header Data Manipulation After BOM/Routing Check            .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_HEADER_MATERIAL_READ_UC Header Data Manip. After Reading Matl Master in Unit Costing.
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_ITEM_ADD_DATA_READ_UC   Itemization Item Data Manipulation in Unit Costing          .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_ITEM_PROCESSING_UC      Line Item Data Manipulation in Unit Costing After Valuation .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_ITEM_VALUATE            Itemization Item Data Manipulation After Valuation          .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_PROCESS_READ_MACK3      Mat. Data Manipulation After Read MACK3 for Joint Prod. Proc.
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_PRODUCTIONORDER_CREATE  Header Data Manipulation After Creating Temp. Prod. Order   .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_QUANT_STRU_DETERMINATIONHeader Data Manipul. After Structure Determ. (Raw Mat/Assem).
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I AFTER_STRATIFICATION_UC       Header Data Manipulation in Unit Costing Before Saving      .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I BEFORE_BOM_ROUT_CHECK         Header Data Manipulation Before BOM/Routing Check           .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I BEFORE_BOM_SELECTION          Header Data Manipulation Before BOM Determination/Explosion .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I BEFORE_ITEM_CREATE            Item Data Manipulation Before Transfer into Itemization     .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_BOM_ITEM_GET               BOM Item Data Manip. Before Processing in Structure Explosio.
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_BOM_ITEM_SET               BOM Item Data Manipulation Before Transfer as Costing Object.
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_COPROD_LOTSIZE_COMPUTE     Lot Size Calculation for Co-Products                        .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_COSTING_HEADER_CREATE      At End of Costing an Object                                 .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_COSTING_HEADER_CREATE_UC   Header Data Manipulation in Unit Costing                    .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_LOTSIZE_CHANGE_UC          After Lot Size Change in Unit Costing                       .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_LOTSIZE_COMPUTE            Lot Size Calculation for the Material to Be Costed          .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_MATERIAL_CHECK_MACK3       Material Master Data Manipulation After Importing in MACK3  .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_MATERIAL_CHECK_MACK4       Material Master Data Manipulation After Importing in MACK4  .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_PROCESS_LOTSIZE_COMPUTE    Lot Size Calculation for Process Material                   .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I ON_PROC_ALT_MATERIAL_READ     Material Master Data Manipulation with ProcurementAlt Maint..
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I QUANT_STRU_GET                Transfer Input/Output Relationships                         .
IF_EX_QUANTITY_STRUCT_CK       I QUANT_STRU_SOURCE_DETERMINE   Determines Where the Quantity Structure Should Be Taken From.
IF_EX_RAT_PROCUREMENT_TYPE     I BADI_RAT_DETERMINE_PROCUREMENTProcurement Document Determination                          .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_IND         I UPDATE_REPORT_ACT             Call of the Update of Indirect Actual Data                  .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_IND         I UPDATE_REPORT_PLAN            Call of the Update of Indirect Planning Data                .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_SETTLE      I BONUS_BASE_MODIFY             Adjustment of the Rebate Basis                              .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_SETTLE      I BONUS_DATA_MODIFY             Fill Structures KOMFKGN / KOMFKKO                           .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_SETTLE      I BONUS_METHOD_SELECT           Method for Scales Settlement and Assignment of Fixed Values .
IF_EX_RBT_ENH_BADI_SETTLE      I BONUS_VALUES_MODIFY           Adjust Rebate Payment                                       .
IF_EX_RCM_WD_SP_ACTIVITIES     I GET_DEFAULT_MODEL_ACTIVITY    Default activity used to create element instance in record  .
IF_EX_RCP_AUTHORITY_CHECK      I CHECK_BBL_AUTH                Authorization for a Building Block                          .
IF_EX_RCP_AUTHORITY_CHECK      I CHECK_RCP_AUTH                Authorization Check for Recipes                             .
IF_EX_RCP_AUTHORITY_CHECK      I CHECK_RCP_AUTH_F4             F4 Help: Authorization Check for Recipes                    .
IF_EX_RCP_AUTHORITY_CHECK      I CHECK_RCP_STATUS_AUTH         Checks Whether Changes to a Recipe Status Are Allowed       .
IF_EX_RCP_CONSISTENT_CHECK     I FRML_CONS_CHECK_AND_SET       Check and Set Consistency of Formula                        .
IF_EX_RCP_CONSISTENT_CHECK     I FRML_CONS_SET_NO_CHECK        Set Consistency of Formula Without Check                    .
IF_EX_RCP_CONSISTENT_CHECK     I FRML_CONS_UNSET               Deselect Consistent Indicator in Formula                    .
IF_EX_RCP_CONSISTENT_CHECK     I RECIPE_CHECK                  Check Consistency of Recipe                                 .
IF_EX_RCP_CONSISTENT_CHECK     I RECIPE_CONS_UNSET             Deselect Consistent Indicator in Recipe                     .
IF_EX_RCP_COPY_RCP_DATA        I DATA_READ                     Read Own Data                                               .
IF_EX_RCP_COPY_RCP_DATA        I DATA_WRITE_BB_TO_BB           Write Own Data (Building Block -" Building Block)           .
IF_EX_RCP_COPY_RCP_DATA        I DATA_WRITE_BB_TO_DO           Write Own Data (Building Block -" Dependent Object)         .
IF_EX_RCP_COPY_RCP_DATA        I DATA_WRITE_DO_TO_BB           Write Own Data (Dependent Object -" Building Block)         .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_EQR_DATA               Delete Own Data for an Equipment Requirement                .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_PAC_DATA               Delete Own Data for an Action                               .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_POP_DATA               Delete Own Data for an Operation                            .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_PRO_DATA               Delete Own Data for a Process                               .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_PST_DATA               Delete Own Data for a Stage                                 .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETE_RCP_DATA      I DELETE_RCP_DATA               Delete Own Data for a Recipe                                .
IF_EX_RCP_DELETION_CHECK       I CHECK_RCP_FOR_DELETION        Checks Whether the Recipe Can Be Deleted                    .
IF_EX_RCP_GR_TO_MR_ALLOWED     I IS_TRANSFER_GR_TO_MR_ALLOWED  Check Whether GR -" MR Transfer is Allowed                  .
IF_EX_RCP_LONG_TEXT_POPUP      I CHECK_DISPLAY_POPUP           Check If Long Text Dialog Box Is Displayed for Dep.Formulas .
IF_EX_RCP_PREF_RCP_CHECK       I PREF_RCP_CHECK                Checks Whether Preferred Recipe Can Be Set                  .
IF_EX_RCP_REGISTER_EVENTS      I RCP_EVENTS_ADD                Own Registration for Events of Recipe Objects               .
IF_EX_RCP_SAVE_RCP_DATA        I SAVE_EQR_DATA                 Write Own Equipment Requirement Data to Database            .
IF_EX_RCP_SAVE_RCP_DATA        I SAVE_POB_DATA                 Write Own Process Data to Database                          .
IF_EX_RCP_SAVE_RCP_DATA        I SAVE_RCP_DATA                 Write Own Recipe Data to Database                           .
IF_EX_RCP_STATUS_BUT_CHECK     I BUTTON_DEACTIVATE_CHECK       Checks Whether Status Pushbutton Is to Be Deactivated       .
IF_EX_RCP_VALIDITY_CHECK       I CHECK_STATUS_CHANGE           Check for Status Change                                     .
IF_EX_RCP_VALIDITY_CHECK       I VALIDITY_CHECK                Check for Validity Change Based on Current Status           .
IF_EX_RCP_VERSION_CHECK        I VERSION_CREATION_CHECK        Checks Whether Version Can Be Created                       .
IF_EX_RCP_VERSION_CHECK        I VERSION_DELETION              Writes Deletion Entry for Version                           .
IF_EX_RCP_VERSION_CHECK        I VERSION_DELETION_CHECK        Checks Whether Version Can Be Deleted                       .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSMENT_TASK      I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSMENT_TASK      I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSMENT_TASK      I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSMENT_TASK      I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSMENT_TASK      I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I ADJUSTMENT                    Execution of Adjustment                                     .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I CAPPING                       Execution of Capping                                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I GET_ADJMRULE_FOR_INSERT       Gets Possible Adjustment Methods for Adding                 .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I GET_ADJUSTMENT_VALUE          Gets the Value for a Variable of the Control Table          .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Gets Field Catalog for Adjustment Transactions              .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT          I GET_FIELDCATALOG_VALUE        Gets Value for a Field Catalog Entry                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_RLRA     I GET_BASE_RENT                 Gets the Base Rent                                          .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_RLRA     I GET_COMPARATIVE_RENT          Gets Comparative Rent                                       .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I DISTRIBUTE                    Distributes the Costs                                       .
IF_EX_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK     I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP       I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP       I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP       I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP       I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP       I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT         I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT         I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT         I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT         I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT         I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Building Number with Internal Number Assignment   .
IF_EX_REBD_BUILDING            I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Number of BE in Case of Internal Number Assignment.
IF_EX_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY     I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBD_MEAS_CUST           I CHANGE_MEAS_CUST_LIST         Changes Measurement Type Settings Using Business Object     .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Property Number with Internal Number Assignment   .
IF_EX_REBD_PROPERTY            I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Number of RO with Internal Number Assignment      .
IF_EX_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT       I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REBP_ATTRIB_DETERM       I DETERMINE_BU_GROUP            Determination of Partner Grouping                           .
IF_EX_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT    I CHECK                         Checks If Data Object Is to Be Archived                     .
IF_EX_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT    I DELETE                        Deletes Data from Database                                  .
IF_EX_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT    I READ_INTO_BUFFER              Reads Exactly One Data Object from Archive                  .
IF_EX_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT    I WRITE                         Places Data of Data Object in Archive File                  .
IF_EX_RECA_BDT                 I BDT_APPL_AFTER_CREATE_POPUP   BDT Tool: After the Popup for Creating an Object            .
IF_EX_RECA_BDT                 I BDT_FRAME_GET_SCREEN_SEQUENCE BDT Frame: Determine Screen Sequence                        .
IF_EX_RECA_BUSINESS_DATE       I CALCULATE_BUSINESS_DATE       Determine a Working Day                                     .
IF_EX_RECA_MESSAGE             I CHANGE_CUSTOMIZED_MESSAGE     Changes Message Type of a Customized Message                .
IF_EX_RECA_RESUBMISSION        I CALCULATE_DATE_LIST           Calculates List of Dates for Resubmission Rule Entered      .
IF_EX_RECA_RESUBMISSION        I CHANGE_OUTPUT_DATA            Changes List of Resubmission Dates to Be Output             .
IF_EX_RECA_RESUBMISSION        I CREATE_ORGANIZER_APPT         Changes Characteristics of Date for SAP Appointment Calendar.
IF_EX_RECA_SEARCH_METHOD       I GET_SHMETHDIFF                Determines Initial Values for VICASHFVALUES-SHMETHDIFF      .
IF_EX_RECA_SEARCH_METHOD       I GET_VALUES                    Determines Poss. Field Values from Object Data/Name Strategy.
IF_EX_RECA_SEARCH_METHOD       I GET_VALUES_FOR_SHMETHDIFF     Determines Poss.Field Values for a Differentiation Criterion.
IF_EX_RECA_STORABLE_EXT        I CREATE_INSTANCE               Generates Instance of Extendable Object                     .
IF_EX_RECA_STORABLE_EXT        I GET_OBJNAME_EXT               Supplies Class/Interface Names for Extendable Objects       .
IF_EX_RECA_WB                  I BROWSER_TREE_INFOSYSTEM       Adjust Information System Report Tree                       .
IF_EX_RECA_WB                  I BUSOBJ_DISPLAY                Display of a Business Object                                .
IF_EX_RECA_WB                  I FILTER_SUBNODE                Filtering of Subordinate Node in RE Navigator               .
IF_EX_RECA_WB                  I FILTER_SUBNODES               Filter Subordinate Nodes in RE Navigator                    .
IF_EX_RECA_WB                  I NAVIGATION                    Navigation to a Business Object (e.g. Tab Page)             .
IF_EX_RECD_CALC_RULE           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Gets the Attributes                                         .
IF_EX_RECD_CALC_RULE           I GET_PARAMETER                 Gets the Parameter Values                                   .
IF_EX_RECD_CALC_RULE           I GET_UNITS                     Gets Units                                                  .
IF_EX_RECD_CALC_RULE           I GET_VALUES                    Supplies the Calculation Amounts                            .
IF_EX_RECD_CASHFLOW            I CHANGE_CASHFLOW_OBJ           Object Cash Flow: Change Data                               .
IF_EX_RECD_CASHFLOW            I CHANGE_CASHFLOW_PAY           Partner-Related Cash Flow: Change Data                      .
IF_EX_RECD_CONDITION           I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RECD_CONDITION           I GET_ADJUSTMENT_RULE           Makes It Possible to Supply Default Value for Adj. Rule     .
IF_EX_RECD_DIST_RULE           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Gets the Attributes                                         .
IF_EX_RECD_DIST_RULE           I GET_PARAMETER                 Gets the Parameter Values                                   .
IF_EX_RECD_DIST_RULE           I GET_UNIT                      Delivers Unit                                               .
IF_EX_RECD_DIST_RULE           I GET_VALUES                    Supplies the Distribution Amounts                           .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I AFTER_OBJECT_REL_CHANGE       Change or Add Data After Changing Object Assignment         .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Contract Number with Internal Number Assignment   .
IF_EX_RECN_CONTRACT            I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RECP_OI                  I CHANGE_DOC_DATA               Changes Data Before Transfer to Office Application          .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I APP_OPTIONS_INIT              Initializes Settings                                        .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I CHANGE_DOC_DATA               Changes Attributes of Document                              .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I CHANGE_DOC_LIST               Changes the Entire Document List                            .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I CHECK_BUSOBJ_RELEVANCE        Checks If Real Estate Object Should Be Considered           .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I FP_CLOSE                      PDF-Based Form: Closes Current Output Request               .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I FP_OPEN                       PDF-Based Form: Opens New Output Request                    .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I FP_PREVIEW                    PDF-Based Form: Displays Print Preview                      .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I FP_PRINT                      PDF-Based Form: Prints Document                             .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I GET_DIFF_CHARACTERISTIC       Provides Differentiation Characteristic for CorrAppl/BusObj .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I SF_CLOSE                      Smart Form: Closes Current Output Request                   .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I SF_OPEN                       Smart Form: Opens New Output Request                        .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I SF_PREVIEW                    Smart Form: Displays Print Preview                          .
IF_EX_RECP_SF                  I SF_PRINT                      Smart Form: Prints Document                                 .
IF_EX_REEX_FI_BAPI             I BAPIDOC_MODIFY                Changes Document Data Before Call of FI BAPI                .
IF_EX_REEX_FI_DUNNING          I MODIFY_DUNNINGITEM_RECIPIENT  Modification of Dunning Items for Dunning Recipient         .
IF_EX_REEX_FI_GET_GLACCT       I CHANGE_KEYDATE                Change Key Date                                             .
IF_EX_REEX_FI_GET_GLACCT       I REPLACE_ALL                   Replace Account Determination                               .
IF_EX_REEX_FUNC_LOC            I ADAPT_DATA                    Adjust Data of RE Functional Location                       .
IF_EX_REEX_FUNC_LOC            I GENERATE_LABEL                Generates Name of Automatic Functional Location             .
IF_EX_REEX_FUNC_LOC            I UPDATE_CLASSIFICATION         Classification of RE Functional Locations                   .
IF_EX_REFERENCE_SITE           I READ_REFERENCE_SITE           Returns reference site                                      .
IF_EX_REF_CUSTOMER_XI_GET      I GET_REF_CUSTOMER              Determines Sample Customer XI Inbox                         .
IF_EX_REIS_LIST                I CHANGE_DISPLAY_OPTIONS        Changs the Display Attributes                               .
IF_EX_REIS_LIST                I CHANGE_OUTPUT_DATA            Changes the Data to Be Output                               .
IF_EX_REIS_RM                  I CREATE_RECORD                 Creates a New Record                                        .
IF_EX_REIT_DATE_OF_SERVICE     I GET_DATE_OF_SERVICE           Determine Date of Service                                   .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Number of BE in Case of Internal Number Assignment.
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT     I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJ_ASSIGN I BEFORE_PROCESSING             Before Determination of Default Objects                     .
IF_EX_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJ_ASSIGN I CHANGE_PROPOSAL               Change Default Values                                       .
IF_EX_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY     I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY     I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY     I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY     I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY     I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RELM_LAND_REGISTER       I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_LAND_REGISTER       I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_LAND_REGISTER       I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_LAND_REGISTER       I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_LAND_REGISTER       I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT   I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT   I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT   I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT   I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT   I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_LRPAGENO     I NUMBER_INPUT                  External -" Internal (Input)                                .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_LRPAGENO     I NUMBER_OUTPUT                 Internal -" External (Output)                               .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_LRREGNO      I NUMBER_INPUT                  External -" Internal (Input)                                .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_LRREGNO      I NUMBER_OUTPUT                 Internal -" External (Output)                               .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_PLNO         I NUMBER_INPUT                  External -" Internal (Input)                                .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_PLNO         I NUMBER_OUTPUT                 Internal -" External (Output)                               .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_SECNO        I NUMBER_INPUT                  External -" Internal (Input)                                .
IF_EX_RELM_NUMBER_SECNO        I NUMBER_OUTPUT                 Internal -" External (Output)                               .
IF_EX_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND      I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND      I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND      I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND      I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND      I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE  I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE  I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE  I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE  I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE  I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE       I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE       I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE       I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE       I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE       I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REMM_MANDATE             I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REMM_MANDATE             I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REMM_MANDATE             I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REMM_MANDATE             I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REMM_MANDATE             I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REMM_OBJ_ADOPT           I CHANGE_COPY_PARAMETER         Change of Data Being Copied for Object                      .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Contract Offer Number with Int. Number Assignment .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER               I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Building Number with Internal Number Assignment   .
IF_EX_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT        I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Building Number with Internal Number Assignment   .
IF_EX_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST      I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_REOR_SEARCH              I HITLIST_MODIFY                Modification of Hit List of Search                          .
IF_EX_REOR_SEARCH              I WHERE_CLAUSE_MODIFY           Modification of Where Term for Search                       .
IF_EX_REQ_ATP_CHECK            I ME_REQ_ATP_CHECK_ALLOWED      ATP Check for Purchase Requisition?                         .
IF_EX_RERA_ACCT_SHEET          I MODIFY_ACCT_STATEMENT         Adjustment of Account Statement                             .
IF_EX_RERA_ACCT_SHEET          I MODIFY_GRID_SUMMARY           Adjustment of Overview Data Output in Contract Acct Sheet   .
IF_EX_RERA_ACCT_SHEET          I MODIFY_ITEM_LIST              Adjustment of Item List                                     .
IF_EX_RERA_ACCT_SHEET          I MODIFY_OI_ACCT_DETAIL         Adjustment of Detail Data for Partner Account               .
IF_EX_RERA_ACCT_SHEET          I MODIFY_SUMMARY                Adjustment of Overview Data in Contract Account Sheet       .
IF_EX_RERA_ADVPAY              I GET_ADVPAY                    Supplies Advance Payments                                   .
IF_EX_RERA_DOC                 I AFTER_POST                    After Posting of RE Document                                .
IF_EX_RERA_DOC                 I AFTER_REVERSE                 After Reversal of RE Document                               .
IF_EX_RERA_DOC                 I BEFORE_POST                   Before Posting of RE Document (Change of Document Data)     .
IF_EX_RERA_DOC                 I BEFORE_REVERSE                Before Reversal of RE Document                              .
IF_EX_RERA_INVOICE             I ADAPT_INVOICE_ITEM_LIST       Makes It Possible to Ignore/Adjust Invoice Items            .
IF_EX_RERA_INVOICE             I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Additional Actions After Creating an Invoice        .
IF_EX_RERA_INVOICE             I CHECK_IGNORE_CONTRACT         Makes Possible to Ignore Contracts During Invoice Creation  .
IF_EX_RERA_INVOICE             I GET_NUMBER                    Makes Determining a Specific Invoice Number Possible        .
IF_EX_RERA_INVOICE             I GROUP_INVOICE_ITEM_LIST       Makes Specific Grouping of Items for Invoices Possible      .
IF_EX_RERA_OP                  I COMPLETE_BASE_DATA            Completes the Basic Data                                    .
IF_EX_RERA_OP                  I COMPLETE_HEADER_DATA          Completes the Document Header Data (All Documents)          .
IF_EX_RERA_OP                  I COMPLETE_ITEM_DATA            Completes the Line Item Data (All Line Items)               .
IF_EX_RESC_INFO_SYSTEM         I ADAPT_REPORTS                 Supplies the Reports                                        .
IF_EX_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP      I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP      I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP      I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP      I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP      I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I ADAPT_METER_ASSIGNMENT        Changes the Meter Being Considered                          .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I GET_APPORTVALUE_FOR_OBJECT    Supplies Reference Factor for a Single Object               .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I GET_APPORTVALUE_FOR_SU        Supplies Reference Factor                                   .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I REVERSE                       Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_AF        I USE_EXTERNAL_CALCULATION      Should Different Calculation of Reference Factor Be Used    .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_BC        I GET_TRANSFER_PROPERTIES       Gets the Properties for the Transfer                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_DC        I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_DC        I CALCULATE_EXTRACHARGE         Calculates Management Costs Surcharge                       .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_DC        I DISTRIBUTE_FROM_SU            Distributes Costs from (Normal) SU to RO/Contract           .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_DC        I REVERSE                       Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_DC        I USE_EXTERNAL_DISTRIBUTION     Should a Different Apportionment Rule Be Used               .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_GC        I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_GC        I GET_EXTERNAL_COSTS            Read External Costs                                         .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_GC        I REVERSE                       Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_SH        I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_SH        I CHANGE_CURRENT_OCCUPANT       Change Current Occupant                                     .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTLSTEP_SH        I REVERSE                       Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTL_UNIT          I AFTER_DELETE                  Delete Data From Additional Tables                          .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTL_UNIT          I AFTER_STORE                   Perform Further Actions After Saving                        .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTL_UNIT          I BEFORE_DELETE                 Carry Out Additional Checks Before Deletion                 .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTL_UNIT          I CHECK_ALL                     Performa Additional Checks (Validation)                     .
IF_EX_RESC_SETTL_UNIT          I SUBSTITUTE                    Change or Add to Data (Substitution)                        .
IF_EX_RESC_TAPE                I BEFORE_IMPORT_D_TAPE          Before Importing the D-Tape                                 .
IF_EX_RESC_TAPE                I CHANGE_L_PART                 Change L Part of M/L-Tape                                   .
IF_EX_RESC_TAPE                I CHANGE_M_PART                 Change M Part of M/L-Tape                                   .
IF_EX_RESC_TAPE                I CHECK_D_PART                  Checks a D Record                                           .
IF_EX_RESC_TAPE                I CHECK_D_TAPE                  Checks Entire D-Tape                                        .
IF_EX_RESR_CALC_RENT           I CALCULATE                     Calculation of Sales-Based Rent                             .
IF_EX_REVAL_CONS               I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Checks whether revaluation of consumption package is active .
IF_EX_REVAL_CONS               I CHECK_CATEGORY                Check Category in CKM3_GET_CATEGORY                         .
IF_EX_REVAL_CONS               I CHECK_PROCESS_TYPE            Check Original Process Category in CKM3_GET_CATEGORY        .
IF_EX_REVAL_CONS               I CREATE_POSTINGS               Subsequent Posting of Single-Level Consumption              .
IF_EX_REVAL_CONS               I WRAP_ACCOUNT_INFO             Encrypted FI/CO Account Assignment for ML Update            .
IF_EX_REV_SELECT               I SELECT_INDIVIDUAL             Selection                                                   .
IF_EX_REXA_CONTRACT_ACCOUNT    I AFTER_CREATE                  Additional Actions after Creation of Contract Account       .
IF_EX_REXA_CONTRACT_ACCOUNT    I BEFORE_CREATE                 Change Data before Creation of Contract Account             .
IF_EX_REXA_DERIVE_FM_ACCT      I DERIVE_FM_ACCT                Derive FM Account Assignments                               .
IF_EX_REXA_FC_BAPI             I BAPIDOC_MODIFY                Changes Document Data before BAPI Call                      .
IF_EX_REXCFC_ACCOUNT           I CONSUMPTION                   FI Posting: Consumption                                     .
IF_EX_REXCFC_ACCOUNT           I OPEN_BALANCE                  FI Posting: Initial Level                                   .
IF_EX_RFEBNORDIC_SECURITY      I CALL_SECURITY_KIT             Call Authentication Software                                .
IF_EX_RFESR000_BADI_002        I GROUP_ITEMS                   Group Items according XREF1                                 .
IF_EX_RFFMFG_TREA_OFFSET       I CONTROL_RECORD                Control Record                                              .
IF_EX_RFFMFG_TREA_OFFSET       I DEBT_INFO                     Debt Information                                            .
IF_EX_RFFMFG_TREA_OFFSET       I GET_DATE_FIELD                Define date used in ageing calculation                      .
IF_EX_RFFMFG_TREA_OFFSET       I INDIVIDUAL_DEBTOR_INFO        Individual Debtor Information File Format                   .
IF_EX_RFIDATEB00_BADI_001      I MODIFY_NOTE_TO_PAYEE          Change Note to Payee in Field 86                            .
IF_EX_RFIDTRBOE1_BADI_001      I CHANGE_SELECTION              Change Dynamic Selections                                   .
IF_EX_RFIDTRBOE2_BADI_001      I CHANGE_SELECTION              Change Dynamic Selections                                   .
IF_EX_RFIDTRWEKO_BADI_001      I CHANGE_SELECTION              Change Dynamic Selections                                   .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_001      I PST_COST_LINE                 Post VAT Pro-Rata cost line                                 .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_001      I PST_VAT_LINE                  Post VAT Pro-Rata VAT line                                  .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_002      I SEL_EXC_DOC_TX                Exclude Pro-Rata selection document items by doc/tax code   .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_003      I SEL_EXC_DOC_ITEM              Exclude Pro-Rata previous adjustment document items         .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_010      I V_PROG_CUSTOP_ASSET           Change Parameters on Customizing Options Tab for Asset      .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_010      I V_PROG_CUSTOP_ASSET_INVOICE   Change Parameters on Customizing Tab for Asset/Invoice Line .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_020      I CALC_CHANGE_ADJUST_A          Change VAT Pro-Rata Adjustment Amount - Assets              .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_020      I CALC_CHANGE_ADJUST_S          Change VAT Pro-Rata Adjustment Amount - Mat. & Services     .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_020      I CALC_CHANGE_COEF_A            Change VAT Pro-Rata Adjustment Coefficient - Assets         .
IF_EX_RFID_PTVPR_BADI_020      I CALC_CHANGE_COEF_S            Change VAT Pro-Rata Adjustment Coefficient - Mat. & Services.
IF_EX_RHPV0001                 I CHECK_BOOKING                 BadI for Checks When Prebooking/Booking/Replacing/Rebooking .
IF_EX_RHPV0001                 I CHECK_CANCELLATION            BAdI for Checks on Attendance Cancellation                  .
IF_EX_RHPV0001                 I SET_BOOKING_CHECKS            Activate/Deactivate Checks                                  .
IF_EX_RH_ORGCHART              I CALL_ORGCHARTER               Start evaluation and if necessary charting tools            .
IF_EX_RH_ORGCHART              I CHECK_ORGCHARTER_EXISTS       Check whether function should be offered on interface       .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I ADD_AGENT                     Determine Additional Processors                             .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Activate Additional Authorization Check                     .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I BEFORE_ADD                    Fill Additional Fields When Adding Objects                  .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I BEFORE_RELEASE                Checks Before Releasing the Release Object                  .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I BEFORE_REMOVAL                Checks Before Removing Release Object                       .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I BEFORE_SAVE                   Fill Additional Fields in Order Before Saving               .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I EXEC_EXTENSION_FCODE          Menu Enhancements                                           .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I GET_PRINT_PROGRAM             Determine Print Program                                     .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I GET_WORKFLOW_TEMPLATE         Specify Workflow Pattern                                    .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I HD_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN       Additional Header Data - Transport Data from Screen         .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I HD_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN         Additional Header Data - Transport Data to Screen           .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I HD_TAB_ACTIVATE               Additional Header Data - Activate Tab Pages                 .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I POS_GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN      Additional Item Data - Transport Data from Screen           .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I POS_PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN        Additional Item Data - Transport Data to Screen             .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I SAVE                          Save Additional Data                                        .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I SELECT_NEW                    Specify Release Objects to Add to Order                     .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I USE_ASYNC_UPDATE_TASK         Post Data Asynchronously                                    .
IF_EX_RLMFW                    I VALIDATE_OBJECT               Validate Release Object                                     .
IF_EX_RLMFW_CMP                I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transport Additional Data from Screen                       .
IF_EX_RLMFW_CMP                I LOAD_FROM_IPPE                Determine Data for Variant Change Status                    .
IF_EX_RLMFW_CMP                I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transport Additional Data to Screen                         .
IF_EX_RLMFW_CMP                I RELEASE                       Release Variant Change Status                               .
IF_EX_RL_ACST                  I CHANGE_KOMKBRS_PARTNER        Change of Construct and Partner Table NAST (Appl. RS)       .
IF_EX_RL_ACST                  I CHANGE_PRINT_DATA             Change Printing Data                                        .
IF_EX_RL_ACSTREQ_IN            I CHANGE_ACCSTAREQ              Change Request Data for Account Determination/Conversion    .
IF_EX_RL_ACSTREQ_OUT           I CHANGE_SEGMENT_DATA           Change Data of an IDoc Segment (ACCSTARQ)                   .
IF_EX_RMPS_AUT_KEY_GENSP       I DETERMINE_KEY                 Form Authorization Key                                      .
IF_EX_RMPS_DLMAP_ATTRIBUTS     I MAP_RMATTR2TXT                Mapping RM Attribute -" Download Attribute (example X.500)  .
IF_EX_RMPS_EXTERNAL_OUTPUT     I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES             Influence Attribute Tables for Print, Mail                  .
IF_EX_RMPS_EXTERNAL_OUTPUT     I CONVERT_DOCUMENT              Convert Document Contents to Any Target Format              .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I ADD_ITEMS                     Extensions Column Content                                   .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I BROWSE_ELEMENT                Extensions Display/Read Attributes                          .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I COLLECT_ELEMENT               Extensions Save Attribute Values                            .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I CONV_XML_TO_CM                Extensions Convert XML Content to Content Model Content     .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I CREATE_ELEMEDIT_DYN_DOC       Extensions Selection Fields Dynamic Document                .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I GET_DESCR_4_ID                Extensions Header Texts for Extra Columns                   .
IF_EX_RMPS_FILEPLAN_ADDON      I GET_LAYOUT_DEFAULT            Extensions Definitions of Extra Columns                     .
IF_EX_RMPS_GET_MAIL_RECVRS     I GET_RECIPIENTS                Determine Default Mail Receiver                             .
IF_EX_RMPS_INIT_DOC_ATTR_S     I INIT_ATTRIBUTES               Initialization of Attributes When Creating Document         .
IF_EX_RMPS_PATH_FIELDS         I MAUNUAL_ACT_PROCESSING        Enter Media Inconsistency Manually                          .
IF_EX_RMPS_PATH_FIELDS         I SAVE_MANUAL_PROCESSING        Exit for Saving Process Route for External Step Case        .
IF_EX_RMPS_PATH_FIELDS         I SET_OUTPUT_VALUE              Editing of Display Fields in Process Route                  .
IF_EX_RMPS_PATH_MANPROC        I MAUNUAL_ACT_PROCESSING        Enter Media Inconsistency Manually                          .
IF_EX_RMPS_PATH_MANPROC        I SAVE_MANUAL_PROCESSING        Exit for Saving Process Route for External Step Case        .
IF_EX_RMPS_POST_DEFATTR        I PUBLISH_MAIL_DOCTYPES         Publishing of Possible E-Mail Document Types                .
IF_EX_RMPS_POST_DEFATTR        I SET_DEFAULTS_IMAGE            Set Attribute Values Incoming Scans                         .
IF_EX_RMPS_POST_DEFATTR        I SET_DEFAULTS_MAIL_BOR         Set Attribute Values Incoming Mail using BOR (SO28)         .
IF_EX_RMPS_POST_DEFATTR        I SET_DEFAULTS_MAIL_SMTP        Set Attribute Values Incoming Mail using SMTP (SO50)        .
IF_EX_RMPS_POST_DEFATTR        I SET_MAIL_DOCTYPE              Set E-Mail Document Type                                    .
IF_EX_RMPS_RECORD_C            I AFTER_SAVE                    Event Record was Saved                                      .
IF_EX_RMPS_RECORD_C            I BEFORE_DELETE                 Permit Movement of Element in the Record                    .
IF_EX_RMPS_RECORD_C            I BEFORE_DROP                   Permit Deletion of Element in the Record                    .
IF_EX_RMPS_RECORD_C            I BEFORE_INSERT                 Permit Insertion of the Element in the Record               .
IF_EX_RMPS_RESUBMISSION        I BEFORE_SAVE                   Before saving (and deleting) resubmission                   .
IF_EX_RMPS_RESUB_PATTERN       I PATTERN_EVALUATE              Calculate Resubmission Date from Template                   .
IF_EX_RMPS_SWISSKNIFE          I HANDLE_MULTI_VALUE_LIST       Display/Maintenance of All Values of a Multi-Value Attribute.
IF_EX_RMPS_SWISSKNIFE          I HIDE_MAINTAINABLE_ATTRIBUTES  Get list of changeable attributes not to be displayed       .
IF_EX_RMPS_SWISSKNIFE          I PERFORM_F4_MULTI_VALUE        Execute F4 Help for a Multi-Value Attribute                 .
IF_EX_RMPS_SWISSKNIFE          I PERFORM_F4_SINGLE_VALUE       Execute F4 Help for a Single-Value Attribute                .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_ADD_CLASS_DEF             Add Application-Specific Characteristics                    .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_ADD_DATA                  Add Application-Specific Data                               .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_LAYOUT                    Determine ALV Layout                                        .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I GET_OUTTAB                    Determine 'ALV Outtab' Table                                .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_F4                         Check Routine for F4 Help                                   .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add More Buttons to Toolbar                                 .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I ON_USER_COMMAND               Evaluate User Action                                        .
IF_EX_RMSA_VAI_ADD_INF         I SAVE_TO_DB                    Save                                                        .
IF_EX_RMXT_TRIALPLAN           I AFTER_DATA_CHANGED            After Changing Data                                         .
IF_EX_RMXT_TRIALPLAN           I AFTER_SAVE_SCHEDULE           After Saving Trial Planning                                 .
IF_EX_RMXT_TRIALPLAN           I BEFORE_SAVE_SCHEDULE          Before Saving Trial Planning                                .
IF_EX_RMXT_TRIALPLAN           I INIT_SCHEDULING               Initialization of Trial Planning                            .
IF_EX_RM_BFLUSH_GOODSMVT       I MODIFY_GOODSMVT_AFTER_DIALOG  Backflush: Goods Movements on Goods Receipt                 .
IF_EX_RM_BFLUSH_GOODSMVT       I MODIFY_GOODSMVT_BEFORE_DIALOG Backflush: Goods Movements on Goods Issue                   .
IF_EX_RM_HR_INTEGRATION        I ACTIVATE_HR_INTEGRATION       Activate HR Integration                                     .
IF_EX_RM_HR_INTEGRATION        I CHANGE_HR_DATA                Change the HR Data to Be Posted                             .
IF_EX_RM_HR_INTEGRATION        I CHECK_HR_DATA                 Check of Entered HR Data                                    .
IF_EX_RM_HR_INTEGRATION        I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transport From Subscreen Instance                      .
IF_EX_RM_HR_INTEGRATION        I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transport to Subscreen Instance                        .
IF_EX_RM_LIST_PRODUCTION       I RS_LIST_DATA                  Prepare Data to Create Production List                      .
IF_EX_RM_LIST_PRODUCTION       I SET_RS_PRT_FLG                Set Flag to Create Production List for Each BAdI            .
IF_EX_RM_MF50_ROWS             I HIDE_ROWS                     Hide Lines in Planning Table                                .
IF_EX_RM_PERFORMANCE_DREQ      I ACTIVATE_FILTERING_PO         Activate Filtering of Planned Orders                        .
IF_EX_ROUTING_EXIT             I BYPASS_BUFFER_IN_BOM_EXPLOSIONIgnore Buffering in BOM Explosion                           .
IF_EX_ROUTING_EXIT             I GET_PRODUCTION_RELEVANT_ITEMS BOM Explosion Control: Only Items Relevant to Production    .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I BUILD_SELECTION               Build Selection Table                                       .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_ACTIVITY_COST      Activity Costs                                              .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_COSTCENTER_BUDGET  Cost Center Budgets                                         .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_COSTCENTER_COST    Cost Center Costs                                           .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_ELEMENT_COST       Activity Element Costs                                      .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_NETWORK_COST       Network Costs                                               .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_ORDER_BUDGET       Order Budgets                                               .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_ORDER_COST         Order Costs                                                 .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_ORDER_PLANCOST     Order Plan Costs                                            .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_WBS_BUDGET         WBS Budgets                                                 .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_WBS_COST           WBS Costs                                                   .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I CONVERT_BW_WBS_PLANCOST       WBS Plan Costs                                              .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I FILL_TASK_SEGMENT             Fill Task Segment Data                                      .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I GET_MULTIPLE_OBJECT_LINKS     Get Cost Object Links For Multiple Projects and Tasks       .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I GET_OBJECT_ATTRIBUTES         Get R3 Cost Object Attributes                               .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I GET_OBJECT_LINKS              Get Cost Object Links                                       .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I GET_TASK_DATA                 Get additional task data                                    .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I PROCESS_COSPA_DATA            Process R3  Data From COSPA                                 .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I PROCESS_COSSA_DATA            Process R3  Data From COSSA                                 .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I PROCESS_R3_BUDGET_DATA        Process R3  Budget Data                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_FIN_INTF             I PROCESS_R3_TASK_DATA          Process R3 Task Data                                        .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF001           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF002           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF003           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF004           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF005           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RPM_HR_INTF006           I FILL_IDOC_SEGMENT             To fill segment of Idoc                                     .
IF_EX_RP_RRM_BAPI_PP_READ      I PPDATA_CONTROL                Review Purchasing Prices from Standard Methods              .
IF_EX_RP_RRM_BAPI_PP_READ      I PPDATA_DETERMINATION          Determine Purchasing Prices                                 .
IF_EX_RP_RRM_BAPI_SD_CHECK     I SALES_DATA_CONTROL            Sales Data Control                                          .
IF_EX_RP_RRM_MDSEL_CONTROL     I FILTER_SELECTION              Filter for Materials and Plants                             .
IF_EX_RP_RRM_OUTBOUND          I DOWNLOAD                      Data Export Control in RRM Interface                        .
IF_EX_RSAR_CONNECTOR           I GET                           Read User-Defined Functions                                 .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I ADDITIONAL_PARAMETERS         Do you need more parameters in subsequent processing?       .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I CHANGE_BUPA_DATA              Change Business Partner Data                                .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I CHECK_DATA_COMPLETE           Is BW Data Complete for Object? Can BP be Created?          .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I CHECK_VALID_FOR_TG            May Business Partner be Included in Target Group?           .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I GET_CONTACT_DATA              Determine Contact Person Data                               .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I GET_RELATION_DATA             Determine Data for BP Contact Person Relationship           .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I NEW_PARTNER_NUMBER_PUBLISH    Publish Number of New Business Partner                      .
IF_EX_RSCRM_BUPA_CREATE        I REQUEST_MORE_DATA             Request of Other Data for Objects                           .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_ADA             SQL Statement for Adabas                                    .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_DB2             SQL Statement for DB2 for OS/390                            .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_DB4             SQL Statement for DB2 for AS/400                            .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_DB6             SQL Statement for DB2 Universal Database for Unix / NT      .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_INF             SQL Statement for Informix                                  .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_MSS             SQL Statement for MSS                                       .
IF_EX_RSDBC_SQL_STATEMENT      I SQL_STATEMENT_ORA             SQL Statement for Oracle                                    .
IF_EX_RSD_CUBE_BADI            I AFTER_DELETION                Handling after deletion                                     .
IF_EX_RSD_IOBJ_BADI            I AFTER_DELETION                Handling after deletion                                     .
IF_EX_RSD_IOBJ_BADI            I CHECK                         Object Check                                                .
IF_EX_RSEC_LEGAL_AUDITING      I CHECK_LEGAL_PROTOCOL_AUTH     Authorization Check - Display / Delete Log                  .
IF_EX_RSEC_LEGAL_AUDITING      I CHECK_LEGAL_RELEVANCE         Data-Protection Relevance of InfoProviders/InfoObjects      .
IF_EX_RSEC_LEGAL_AUDITING      I GET_TABLENAME                 Established Table Name with Access Logs                     .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I CHANGE_PROPERTIES             Change of Properties of a Document                          .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I CREATE_PROPERTIES             Creation of Properties of a Document                        .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Deletion of Properties of a Document                        .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I HIERARCHY_RESOLVE             Control of Hierarchy Deletion in Reporting                  .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I SELECT                        Selection of Documents (AWB or Web Application)             .
IF_EX_RSOD_DOC_BADI            I STORE_CONTENT                 Writing Document Content to DB                              .
IF_EX_RSOD_ITEM_DOC            I CHANGE_RENDERING              Modify Output (HTML)                                        .
IF_EX_RSOD_ITEM_DOC_LIST       I CHANGE_RENDERING              Modify Total Output of Item                                 .
IF_EX_RSOD_ITEM_DOC_LIST       I CHANGE_RENDERING_CONTEXT      Change Output of Context (of Selection)                     .
IF_EX_RSOD_ITEM_DOC_LIST       I CHANGE_RENDERING_FUNCTIONS    Modify Output of "Additional Functions" Pushbutton          .
IF_EX_RSOD_ITEM_DOC_LIST       I CHANGE_RENDERING_LIST         Modify Output of Document List                              .
IF_EX_RSOD_WWW_DOC_MAINT       I BEFORE_RENDERING              Option To Modify Document Before Display                    .
IF_EX_RSOD_WWW_DOC_MAINT       I DETERMINE_VERSION_HANDLING    Determine Version Management in Web                         .
IF_EX_RSPC_CHAIN_TRANSPORT     I GET_ADDITIONAL_OBJECTS        Delivers non-BW objects that also have to be transported    .
IF_EX_RSRA_ALERT               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_RSRA_ALERT               I SUBMIT                        Transfer Alert Data                                         .
IF_EX_RSR_OLAP_AUTH_GEN        I MODIFY_USER_DATA              Changing User Data Before Generating User                   .
IF_EX_RSU5_SAPI_BADI           I DATA_TRANSFORM                Business Add-Ins Method for General Data Transfer           .
IF_EX_RSU5_SAPI_BADI           I HIER_TRANSFORM                Business Add-Ins Method for Hierarchy Data Transfer         .
IF_EX_RS_BBS_BADI              I GET_TYPES                     List of All Types                                           .
IF_EX_RS_DME_EXP_ADRULES       I COMMIT                        Commit work                                                 .
IF_EX_RS_DME_EXP_ADRULES       I EXPORT_ASSRULES               Export of association rules                                 .
IF_EX_RS_DME_EXP_ADRULES       I EXPORT_LIS                    Export of large itemsets                                    .
IF_EX_S2L_GROUP_PLNG_ITEMS     I CHECK_MERGABILITY             Checks Whether Two Planning Elements can be Grouped         .
IF_EX_S2L_GROUP_PLNG_ITEMS     I MERGE                         Groups the Current and the Previous Planning Element        .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_ITEM_EXTEN      I ADJUST_GRID_FIELDCAT          Adjustment of Field Catalog for ALV Grid                    .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_ITEM_EXTEN      I ADJUST_LIST_FIELDCAT          Adjustment of Field Catalog for ALV List                    .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_ITEM_EXTEN      I GET_DETAILS                   Fills Customer-Specific Fields for Output Structure         .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_SEG_EXTEN       I ADJUST_GRID_FIELDCAT          Adjustment of Field Catalog for ALV Grid                    .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_SEG_EXTEN       I ADJUST_LIST_FIELDCAT          Adjustment of Field Catalog for ALV List                    .
IF_EX_S2L_PLNG_SEG_EXTEN       I GET_DETAILS                   Fills Customer-Specific Fields for Output Structure         .
IF_EX_S2L_PLN_CALC_FACTORY     I CREATE_PLNG_CALCULATION       Provides an Object for Missing Quantities Calculation       .
IF_EX_S2L_PROPOSAL_CREATOR     I CREATE_PROPOSALS              Creates Replenishment Proposals                             .
IF_EX_S2L_PSEG_CTR_FACTORY     I CREATE_CCY_PSEG_CONTROL       Gets an Object for Planning Control                         .
IF_EX_S95_ALERT_NOTIFICATN     I MAINTENANCE_REQUEST           MaintenanceRequest                                          .
IF_EX_S95_ALERT_NOTIFICATN     I MAINTENANCE_RESPONSE          MaintenanceResponse                                         .
IF_EX_S95_ALERT_NOTIFICATN     I MAINTENANCE_WORK_ORDER        MaintenanceWorkOrder                                        .
IF_EX_S95_ALERT_NOTIFICATN     I PRODUCTION_PERFORMANCE        ProductionPerformance                                       .
IF_EX_S95_ALERT_NOTIFICATN     I PRODUCTION_SCHEDULE           ProductionSchedule                                          .
IF_EX_S95_ENHANCEMENTS         I MAINTENANCE_REQUEST           S95 MaintenanceRequest                                      .
IF_EX_S95_ENHANCEMENTS         I MAINTENANCE_RESPONSE          S95 MaintenanceResponse                                     .
IF_EX_S95_ENHANCEMENTS         I MAINTENANCE_WORK_ORDER        S95 MaintenanceWorkOrder                                    .
IF_EX_S95_ENHANCEMENTS         I PRODUCTION_PERFORMANCE        S95 ProductionPerformance                                   .
IF_EX_S95_ENHANCEMENTS         I PRODUCTION_SCHEDULE           S95 ProductionSchedule                                      .
IF_EX_SAPLJ1BN_EXIT            I CHANGE_UNITS                  Change Number of Handling Units in Nota Fiscal              .
IF_EX_SAPMJBMUADDIN            I GET_PARAMS                    Get Specific Parameter for EDT Category                     .
IF_EX_SAVE_ADD_SHOPDATA_E      I SAVEDATA                      Save Customer Tables for Shops                              .
IF_EX_SBCOS001                 I PREPARE_FEEDBACK_BO           Preparation of Feedback Data Before PopUp Presentation      .
IF_EX_SCAL_CONVERT_DATE        I CONVERT_DATE                  Date Conversion                                             .
IF_EX_SCMA_FLOW_AUTH           I CHECK_FLOW_AUTHORIZATION      Authorization Check for Flow Definitions                    .
IF_EX_SCMA_FLOW_TRANSPORT      I SEQUENCE_TRANSPORT            Calling Up BAdI After Inclusion in Transport Request        .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I ACTION_ALLOWED                Query Whether Action Is Permitted (Change or Schedule)      .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I ADD_TO_TREE_CONTEXT_MENU      Insert Functions for Context-Sensitive Menu in Tree         .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I AUTOMATIC_RECORDING           Automatic Recording of Task Lists                           .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CHANGE_D0100_STATUS           New Status for D0100                                        .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CHANGE_DELETE_LIST            Change List of Task Lists for Deletion                      .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CHANGE_FCODES                 Change Function Codes in Display and Change Mode            .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CHANGE_FIELDCAT               Status in Task List Tree                                    .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CHANGE_STATUS_OVERVIEW        Change User Status in Daily Overview                        .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I CREATE_NEW_TREE               Create a New Task List                                      .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I DELETE_NODE                   Delete a Node in Task List                                  .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I DELETE_TASKLIST               Delete an Entire Task List                                  .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I DISPLAY_ICON_LEGEND_STATUS    Add Status Icons to Icon Legend                             .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I DRAGDROP_ON_TREE              Allow Drag and Drop in Task List                            .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I GET_BATCH_PARAMETERS          Get Parameters To Be Maintained for a Batch Job             .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I HANDLE_STATUS_FCODES_SCHEDULERFunction Codes for Scheduler                                .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I HANDLE_TREE_CTMENU            Functions in Context-Sensitive Menu of Task Tree            .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I INIT_TASKLIST_STATUS          Set Status for Flow Definitions During Transaction Callup   .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I MOVE_ENTRY_TO_TREE            Add Line in Task List                                       .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I MOVE_NODE_UP_DOWN             Move a node                                                 .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I ON_FUNCTION_SELECTED          Perform Function Codes                                      .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I PROJECT_CHANGE_ALLOWED        Prompt Whether Taskl List Can Be Changed                    .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I REFRESH_TASKLIST_STATUS       Refresh Tree (Incl. Status) for Task List                   .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I REPLACE_TREE_BUTTON           Replace Pushbutton for ALV Tree                             .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I RESET_TASKLIST                Reset Project Table for Task List to Database Status        .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SAVE_TASKLIST                 Save Task List                                              .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_BUTTON_INSERT_GROUP       Pushbutton for "Insert Task Group"                          .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_NODE_ATTRIBUTES           Set Properties of a Node                                    .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_NODE_ATTRIBUTES_TO_MEMORY Set Properties of a Node into Memory                        .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_STATUS_NEW_NODE           A New Task Is Always Locked                                 .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_SYSTEM_ATTRIBUTES         Set System Attributes in Task List Line                     .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_TASKLIST_STATUS_MONI      Set Status When Starting/Ending Processing                  .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SET_TASKLIST_STATUS_SCHEDULINGSet Status During Scheduling                                .
IF_EX_SCMA_TREE_STATUS         I SUBMIT_REPORT                 Submit Online Report with Parameters                        .
IF_EX_SCMG_ARCH_DEL_INTERN     I CLEAN_UP                      Additional Activities When Deleting from the DB             .
IF_EX_SCMG_ARCH_PREPROCESS     I IS_CASE_OUTDATED              Check if case should be archived                            .
IF_EX_SCMG_ARCH_PRE_INTERN     I IS_CASE_OUTDATED              Check if case should be archived                            .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_C         I ADD_ROLES                     Add Additional Roles of Current Processor                   .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_C         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_C         I DETERMINE_KEY                 Determine Authorization Key                                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_S         I ADD_ROLES                     Add Additional Roles of Current Processor                   .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_S         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_SCMG_AUTHORITY_S         I DETERMINE_KEY                 Determine Authorization Key                                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_BEFORE_VALID_C      I CHANGE                        Change Case Before Validation                               .
IF_EX_SCMG_BEFORE_VALID_S      I CHANGE                        Change Case Before Validation                               .
IF_EX_SCMG_CASE_EVENT_S        I FINISH                        When Case Destroyed                                         .
IF_EX_SCMG_CASE_FCODE_S        I EXECUTE                       Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_SCMG_CASE_STATUS_VAL     I VALIDATE                      Case: Status (Central Status Administration) - Check Input  .
IF_EX_SCMG_CASE_TYPE_DEF_C     I GET_DEFAULT_CASE_TYPE         Get Default Value for Case Type when Creating Case          .
IF_EX_SCMG_CASE_TYPE_DEF_S     I GET_DEFAULT_CASE_TYPE         Get Default Value for Case Type when Creating Case          .
IF_EX_SCMG_CHNG_BFR_STR_C      I CHANGE                        Change Case Before Validation                               .
IF_EX_SCMG_CHNG_BFR_STR_S      I CHANGE                        Change Case Before Validation                               .
IF_EX_SCMG_INITIALIZE_C        I INITIALIZE                    Enter Values at Creation                                    .
IF_EX_SCMG_INITIALIZE_S        I INITIALIZE                    Change Case Before Validation                               .
IF_EX_SCMG_INIT_STATUS_S       I INIT                          Create Status Object Number                                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_INST_ACTIVITY_S     I CHANGE_INSTANCE_ACTIVITIES    Add/Change/Delete Instance Activities                       .
IF_EX_SCMG_INST_ACTIVITY_S     I PROCESS_ACTIVITY              Process Activity                                            .
IF_EX_SCMG_MERGE_C             I MERGE_CASES                   Case: Merge Cases                                           .
IF_EX_SCMG_MERGE_S             I MERGE_CASES                   Case: Merge Cases                                           .
IF_EX_SCMG_MODL_ACTIVITY_S     I CHANGE_MODEL_ACTIVITIES       Add/Change/Delete Model Activities                          .
IF_EX_SCMG_MODL_ACTIVITY_S     I PROCESS_ACTIVITY              Process Model Activity                                      .
IF_EX_SCMG_RECORD_S            I AFTER_SAVE                    Event Record was Saved                                      .
IF_EX_SCMG_RECORD_S            I BEFORE_DELETE                 Permit Deletion of Element in the Record                    .
IF_EX_SCMG_RECORD_S            I BEFORE_DROP                   Permit Movement of Element in the Record                    .
IF_EX_SCMG_RECORD_S            I BEFORE_INSERT                 Permit Insertion of the Element in the Record               .
IF_EX_SCMG_SET_STATUS_S        I READ                          Read Status                                                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_SPLIT_C             I SPLIT_CASE                    Split case into another one or two                          .
IF_EX_SCMG_SPLIT_S             I SPLIT_CASE                    Split case into another one or two                          .
IF_EX_SCMG_STORE_C             I WAS_SAVED                     Case Saved                                                  .
IF_EX_SCMG_STORE_S             I WAS_SAVED                     Case Saved                                                  .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_C     I ADD_SUBCOMPONENT              Add or Delete Subcomponent, or Change Order                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_C     I FIELD_PROPERTIES              Before Formatting for Displaying Fields                     .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_C     I TERM_ID_SET                   Set Terminology ID for Additional Attributes                .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_C     I VISUALIZATION                 Before Full Visualization, After Formatting for Fields      .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_S     I ADD_SUBCOMPONENT              Add or Delete Subcomponent, or Change Order                 .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_S     I FIELD_PROPERTIES              Before Formatting for Displaying Fields                     .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_S     I TERM_ID_SET                   Set Terminology ID for Additional Attributes                .
IF_EX_SCMG_VISUALIZATION_S     I VISUALIZATION                 Before Full Visualization, After Formatting for Fields      .
IF_EX_SCM_CMX_POC_AUTH         I EXECUTE_INTERNAL              Method for Check                                            .
IF_EX_SCM_CMX_POC_TITLEBAR     I CUSTOMIZE_TITLE_PI            Customizing of Title Bar in PI Sheet                        .
IF_EX_SCM_OPC_HANDLER          I GET_EVENT_HANDLER             Get Event Handler Instance (for OPC Alarms/Events)          .
IF_EX_SCM_OPC_HANDLER          I GET_ITEM_HANDLER              Get Item Handler Instance (for OPC Data Access)             .
IF_EX_SCM_TRM_COORD_ADD_D      I TRM_COORD_ADD                 Add XYZ Coordinates to Field Catalog                        .
IF_EX_SCM_TRM_GR_RELEASE_D     I TRM_GROUP_RELEASE             Release TRM Requests During Group Release                   .
IF_EX_SCM_TRM_RELEVANCE_D      I TRM_RELEVANCE_CHECK           Determine TRM-Relevance                                     .
IF_EX_SCM_TRM_TO_CANCEL1_D     I TRM_TO_CANCEL1                Send TO Cancellation to TRM                                 .
IF_EX_SCM_TRM_TO_CREATE_D      I TRM_TO_CREATE                 Transfer TO Data to TRM                                     .
IF_EX_SDRQCR21_APO             I CHANGE_PAL_AFTER_SELECTION    Aendern Kontingentdaten nach R/3 Datenselektion             .
IF_EX_SDRQCR21_APO             I CHANGE_PAL_SELECTION_METHOD   Deaktivieren der Standardselektion der Kontingentdaten      .
IF_EX_SDRQCR21_APO             I CHANGE_REQS_AFTER_SELECTION   Aendern Bedarfe und Einteilungen nach R/3 Datenselektion    .
IF_EX_SDRQCR21_APO             I CHANGE_REQS_COMPARISON_RESULT Aendern Vergleichsergebnis Bedarfe und SD Auftragstabellen  .
IF_EX_SD_BONUS_CREDIT_NOTE     I HEADER_MAINTAIN               Change Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_SD_BONUS_CREDIT_NOTE     I ITEM_MAINTAIN                 Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_SD_CIN_LV60AU02          I EXCISE_INVOICE_CREATE         BADI billing                                                .
IF_EX_SD_COND_ACCESS_A         I FULL_ACCESS                   Complete Access                                             .
IF_EX_SD_COND_ACCESS_A         I PRESTEP_ACCESS                Prestep Access                                              .
IF_EX_SD_COND_DETAIL           I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Transfer Data (from Screen)                                 .
IF_EX_SD_COND_DETAIL           I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transfer Data (to Screen)                                   .
IF_EX_SD_COND_LOAD_MVA         I LOAD_MULTIVALUED_ATTRIBUTES   Load Multivalue Attributes                                  .
IF_EX_SD_COND_SAVE_A           I CONDITION_SAVE_EXIT           Save Condition                                              .
IF_EX_SD_DMC_ORDER             I SD_DMC_ORDER1                 Inclusion of Credit/Debit Linkage                           .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I RV15C001_EXIT                 Settlement Using Extended Rebate Processing                 .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_DELETE                   Delete a Rebate Agreement                                   .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_DRILLDOWN                Drill-down                                                  .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_MANUAL                   Manual Rebate Payment and Settlement                        .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_SALESVOLUME              Turnover List                                               .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_SCREEN                   Field Selection                                             .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_TTYP_F4                  Input Help for Contract Data                                .
IF_EX_SD_ENH_REBATES           I V13A_VERIFICATION             Verification Level                                          .
IF_EX_SD_KONV_SELECT           I DATA_SELECTION                Method for Data Retrieval and Completion of TKOMV           .
IF_EX_SD_PRICING_COPY          I PRICING_COPY                  Copy Document Conditions                                    .
IF_EX_SECSTORE_APPLICATION     I REGISTER_PREFIX               Registration of Handlers                                    .
IF_EX_SECURITY_ACCOUNT_TRS     I VALIDATE_XT                   Additional Checks of Securities Account Master Data         .
IF_EX_SELECT_TYPE_FOR_DATA     I GET_INDIVIDUAL_DATA           Individual Data Supply                                      .
IF_EX_SELECT_TYPE_FOR_DATA     I REFINE_SELECTED_DATA          Filtering of Document Information                           .
IF_EX_SELECT_TYPE_FOR_DATA     I SELECT_DATA_INDIVIDUAL        Individual Selection                                        .
IF_EX_SEM_BIC_DERIVATIONS      I DERIVE_CHARACTERISTICS        Automatic Derivation of Characteristics                     .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_FORMULA          I EVALUATE                      Evaluates a Formula                                         .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_FORMULA          I SET_KEY                       Provides a Formula Key                                      .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_MM_CHANGE        I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_MM_CHANGE        I GET_DESCRIPTION_DOCU          Description and Documentation                               .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_MM_SEARCH        I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_MM_SEARCH        I GET_DESCRIPTION_DOCU          Description and Documentation                               .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_MM_SEARCH        I GET_INFORMATION               Information                                                 .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I BEFORE_BPS_LAUNCH             Is Called Up Before a BPS Layout Can be Called Up           .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I MODIFY_WEB_REPORT_URL         Modify URL                                                  .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I SET_APPLICATION               Sets Application                                            .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I SET_KEYS                      Sets Application Key                                        .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I SET_MEAS_UNITS                Sets Units for Measures (Measure Catalog)                   .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I SET_TIME                      Set Time Attributes                                         .
IF_EX_SEM_CPM_PRESENTATION     I SET_VARIABLES                 Sets Values for Variables                                   .
IF_EX_SET_RELEASE_PROFILE      I SET_REL_PROFILE_AND_AS_DATA   change release profiles and assignments                     .
IF_EX_SET_SOURCESYSTEM         I SET_SOURCESYSTEM              Set Source System in BW                                     .
IF_EX_SET_STORE_NUMBER_E       I BUILD_WH_SHOP_NUM             Customer-Specific Number Assignment                         .
IF_EX_SET_STORE_NUMBER_E       I CONVERT_NUMBER                Customer-Specific Conversion Function                       .
IF_EX_SFC_PROFILE              I COPY                          Time of Copy: Hold a New Standard Execution Step Assignment .
IF_EX_SFC_PROFILE              I DELETE                        Time of Deletion                                            .
IF_EX_SFC_PROFILE              I ENQUEUE                       Time of Lock: Lock Table for SXS Assignment                 .
IF_EX_SFC_PROFILE              I SAVE                          Time of Save: Delete/Add SXS Assignment                     .
IF_EX_SFW_SWITCH_CHANGED       I POSTPROCESS_SWITCH            Postprocessing (for Example, XPRA, BC Sets)                 .
IF_EX_SHLP_EXIT_PREPARE        I INFORM_ABOUT_CHECK            inform Add-In implementations about a check to occur        .
IF_EX_SHLP_EXIT_PREPARE        I INFORM_ABOUT_F4               inform Add-In implementations about F4 to occur             .
IF_EX_SHLP_EXIT_PREPARE        I TELL_FLT_VAL_BEFORE_F4        tell filter value before the search help exit is performed  .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN3100      Get Method for General Shop Data                            .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN3200      Get Method for Shop Data of Each Distribution Chain         .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN4000      Get Method for Additional Shop Data                         .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN3100        Put Method for General Shop Data                            .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN3200        Put Method for Shop Data of Each Distribution Chain         .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN4000        Put Method for Additional Shop Data                         .
IF_EX_SHOPADDSCREEN_E          I SET_TABSTRIPNAME              Method to Set Tab Strip Names                               .
IF_EX_SIDAT_UPDATE             I ACT_SIDAT_UPDATE              Customer-Defined Determination of Date of Price Simulation  .
IF_EX_SIDAT_UPDATE             I MAT_SIDAT_UPDATE              Customer-Defined Determination of Date of Price Simulation  .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_MM0A_TRANSFER     I CUSTOMS_DOC_STATUS_GET        Determine Purchase Order Status in GTS                      .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_MM0A_TRANSFER     I PURCHASING_DOC_TRANSFER       GTS Transfer: Purchase Order                                .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_MM0B_TRANSFER     I INBOUND_DELIVERY_TRANSFER     GTS Transfer MM Inbound Delivery                            .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_MM0C_TRANSFER     I DELIVERY_BUFFER_FILL          GTS Transfer: Fill Buffer with Delivery Data                .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_MM0C_TRANSFER     I MATERIAL_DOC_TRANSFER         GTS Transfer: Material Documents                            .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_SD0A_TRANSFER     I SALES_DOC_TRANSFER            GTS Transfer: Order                                         .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_SD0B_TRANSFER     I OUTBOUND_DELIVERY_TRANSFER    GTS Transfer Outbound Delivery                              .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_SD0C_TRANSFER     I INVOICE_TRANSFER              GTS Transfer: Billing Document                              .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_TEMP_STORAGE      I TEMP_STORAGE_DELIVERY_TRANSFERTransfer Simulated Goods Movement to SAP GTS                .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_TEMP_STORAGE      I TEMP_STORAGE_MODE_DET         Determination of Delivery Display Status                    .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_TEMP_STORAGE      I TEMP_STORAGE_STATUS_DET       Determine Delivery Storage Status                           .
IF_EX_SLL_PI_TEMP_STORAGE      I TEMP_STORAGE_STATUS_DET_GM    Determine Goods Movement Storage Status                     .
IF_EX_SMI_DATA_EXTRA           I SET_DEMAND_SELECT             Method for Determining Selection Filter for Requirement Sel..
IF_EX_SMI_DATA_EXTRA           I SOURCE_SELECT                 Method for Selecting Sources of Supply                      .
IF_EX_SMI_IDOC_DELVRY_OUT      I CHANGE_BEFORE_SEND            final changes before sending IDoc DELVRY03                  .
IF_EX_SMI_IDOC_PROACT_OUT      I CHANGE_BEFORE_SEND            final changes before sending IDoc PROACT                    .
IF_EX_SMOD_AD010006            I EXIT_SAPLAD14_006             Exit: DP Processor Menu (Screen 100)                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_AD010006            I EXIT_SAPLAD14_008             Change Text for Menu Exit                                   .
IF_EX_SMOD_BG000001            I EXIT_SAPLBG00_001             Customer Enhancement: Warranty Default Values               .
IF_EX_SMOD_ECSBTO01            I EXIT_SAPLEC55_011             IS-U Move-Out: Determine Customer Settings for Move-Out     .
IF_EX_SMOD_ECSBTO02            I EXIT_SAPLEC55_012             IS-U Move-Out: User-Defined Checks                          .
IF_EX_SMOD_EDMLELPV            I EXIT_SAPLEL55_007             ISU: Default Values for Period Consumption                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_001             IS-U: User-Defined Checks in Screen Fields                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_002             IS-U: User-Defined Preassignment of Screen Fields           .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_003             IS-U: User Exit PBO: PBO for Customer Subscreen             .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_004             IS-U: User Exit PAI_BEFORE: Prepares CALL SUBSCREEN PAI     .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_005             IS-U: User Exit PAI_AFTER: Closes CALL SUBSCREEN PAI        .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_006             IS-U: User-Exit OPEN: Starts Preparation of Customer Object .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_007             IS-U: User Exit INPUT:  Checks and Adopts Entries           .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_008             IS-U: User Exit PREPARE_CLOSE: Prepare Closing              .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_009             IS-U: User Exit ACTION: Actions of Customer Subscreen       .
IF_EX_SMOD_EMDK0001            I EXIT_SAPLES20_010             IS-U: User Exit CLOSE: Exits Customer Processing            .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_001       Prepares Customer Subscreen Call of Header Data             .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_002       Prepares CALL SUBSCREEN PAI for Customer Fields             .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_003       Closes CALL SUBSCREEN PAI of Customer Fields                .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_004       Prepares the Item Data Fill with Customer Values            .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_005       Customer-specific Checks on Property Item Data              .
IF_EX_SMOD_EWAPRP01            I EXIT_SAPLEEWA_CLEAN_006       Transfers Customer Field Changes to Property Object         .
IF_EX_SMOD_FMCFBUD1            I EXIT_SAPLFMCF_BUD_001         FYC Budget: Calculation Maximum Transferable Amount         .
IF_EX_SMOD_FMCFBUD1            I RESIDUAL_BUDGET_USE_BFC       Add Non-Transferrable Commitment Budget to Residual Budget  .
IF_EX_SMOD_FMCFBUD2            I EXIT_SAPLFMCF_BUD_002         FYC Budget: Approved/Requested Amount Can Be Negative       .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDDEBOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEBTTR_OL_001    Customer Checks Borrower Change                             .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDDEBOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEBTTR_OL_002    Customer Function Data Transfer from OL                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDDEBUI            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEBTTR_UI_001    Data for the Customer Screen                                .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDDEBUI            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEBTTR_UI_002    Data from the Customer Screen                               .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDDEBUI            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_DEBTTR_UI_003    Tabstrip for CUstomer Screen                                .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPF4            I F4_REASON                     Limit Permitted Payoff Reasons                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPF4            I F4_SKUEND                     Limit Permitted Notice Reasons                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_001     User Exit for Flow Data                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_002     User Exit for Amounts                                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_003     User Exit: Plausiblity Check for Payoff Data                .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_004     User Exit Flow Type Determination                           .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_005     User Exit Transfer of all Relevant Data                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPOL            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_OL_006     User Exit For CHanging Customer Data (Without UI Layer)     .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU1            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_001     Transfer User Data to Subscreen (Administration Data)       .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU1            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_002     Transfer User Data from Subscreen (Administration Data)     .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_003     Activate and Name Customer Tabs                             .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_004     Transfer User Data to Subscreen (Customer Tab 1)            .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_005     Transfer User Data From Subscreen (Customer Tab 1)          .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_006     Transfer User Data to Subscreen (Customer Tab 2)            .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_007     Transfer User Data from Subscreen (Customer Tab 2)          .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_008     Transfer User Data to Subscreen (Customer Tab 3)            .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU2            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_009     Transfer User Data from Subscreen (Customer Tab 3)          .
IF_EX_SMOD_FVDREPU3            I EXIT_SAPLFVD_REPAY_UI_010     User Exit for Additional Data in the Item Overview          .
IF_EX_SMOD_JHTD0008            I EXIT_SAPLJHTD_010             IS-M: Completeness and Plausibility Check for Ad Spec Master.
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I AFTER_SAVE                    After Saving or After Return from Full Dialog               .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_CANCELLATION       Termination: Check Data                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_GIFT               Gift: Check Data                                            .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_PAYMODE            Payment Method: Check Data                                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_RECREATE           Restart: Check Data                                         .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_REDIRECTION        Redirection: Check Data                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_SUSPENSION         Suspension: Check Data                                      .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_SUSP_POSTDELIV     Postponed Delivery: Check Data                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I CHECK_DATA_TRANSFER           Transfer: Check Data                                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I EXIT_SAPLJKSODP_001           Shortened Dialogs for Order Processing                      .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_CANCELLATION              Termination: PBO                                            .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_GIFT                      Gift: PBO                                                   .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_PAYMODE                   Payment Method: PBO                                         .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_RECREATE                  Restart: PBO                                                .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_REDIRECTION               Redirection: PBO                                            .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_SUSPENSION                Suspension: PBO                                             .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_SUSP_POSTDELIV            Postponed Delivery: PBO                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PBO_TRANSFER                  Transfer: PBO                                               .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_CANCELLATION     Termination: Assign Default Values                          .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_GIFT             Gift: Assign Default Values                                 .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_PAYMODE          Payment Method: Assign Default Values                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_RECREATE         Restart: Assign Default Values                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_REDIRECTION      Redirection: Assign Default Values                          .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_SUSPENSION       Suspension: Assign Default Values                           .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_SUSP_POSTDELIV   Postponed Delivery: Assign Default Values                   .
IF_EX_SMOD_JKSOD001            I PREPARE_DATA_TRANSFER         Transfer: Assign Default Values                             .
IF_EX_SMOD_LWVK1001            I EXIT_SAPLWVK1_001             Extend Communication Structure KOMK for Pricing             .
IF_EX_SMOD_LWVK1002            I EXIT_SAPLWVK1_002             Extend Communication Structure KOMP for Pricing             .
IF_EX_SMOD_MPRO0004            I EXIT_SAPMM61W_004             Postprocessing of forecast errors and exception messages    .
IF_EX_SMOD_MRFLB001            I EXIT_RM06EFLB_001             Control Items for Contract Release Order                    .
IF_EX_SMOD_MRFLB001            I EXIT_RM06EFLB_002             Control Items in Release Creation After Tolerance Check     .
IF_EX_SMOD_NIWE0003            I EXIT_SAPLNIW3_001             Individal Determination of Sales Prices                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_NIWE0003            I EXIT_SAPLNIW3_002             Markdown Percentages on Sales Prices                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_OIJTKT_N            I EXIT_SAPMOIJTN_001            PBO Processing                                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_OIJTKT_N            I EXIT_SAPMOIJTN_002            PAI Processing                                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20AARG            I EXIT_SAPLHR_NO_AA_REGISTER_001HR-NO: Flexible handling of worktime                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20AARG            I EXIT_SAPLHR_NO_AA_REGISTER_002HR-NO: Access to organizational attributes                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20CERC            I EXIT_RPCERCV02_02_001         HR-NO: Customer handling of persons with 'UTL1' and 'UTL2'  .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20SSB1            I EXIT_RPSSSBV0_001             HR-no: SSB. Creating alternative positional code mapping    .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20SSB1            I EXIT_RPSSSBV0_002             HR-NO: SSB: Fields special_1 to special_3.                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_PC20SSB1            I EXIT_RPSSSBV0_003             HR-NO: SSB: exit for choosing "ansettelsesdato"             .
IF_EX_SMOD_PCPO0001            I EXIT_RPCIPE00_001             Modify Symbolic Account                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_PCPO0001            I EXIT_RPCIPE00_002             Fill Out Assignment Number and Document Item Text           .
IF_EX_SMOD_PCPO0001            I EXIT_RPCIPE00_003             Fill New Temporary Wage Types in RT (for Old Payroll        .
IF_EX_SMOD_PCPO0001            I EXIT_RPCIPE00_004             Determines Account for Tax Wage Types                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_PSCVL001            I EXIT_SAP0DEPSC_001            Calculate Adjusted Price Modification                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFFMC001            I EXIT_RFFMC001_001             Check Carry Over Flag                                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_010             Customer Exit CP -  Commercial Paper                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_020             Customer Exit FX - Foreign Exchange                         .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_030             Customer Exit OP -  Options                                 .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_040             Customer Exit TD -  Fixed-term Deposit & Deposit at Notice  .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_050             Customer Exit FR -  FRA                                     .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_060             Customer Exit CF -  CAP/FLOOR                               .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_070             Customer Exit SW -  SWAP                                    .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_080             Customer Exit SE -  Securities (Independent of Prod. Cat.)  .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_090             Customer Exit ZZ -  Cash flow-based Transaction             .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_099             Customer Exit ALL -  Refers to Structure TBCO_ALL           .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_100             Customer Exit IR - Interest Rate Instrument                 .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_110             Cust. Exit FIX -  Int. Rate Adjustment Corres. Derivative + .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_120             Customer Exit FC -  Facilities                              .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_130             Customer Exit RP - Repos                                    .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_140             Customer Exit FW - Forwards                                 .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_150             Customer Exit FU - Futures                                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_RFTBCOEX            I EXIT_RFTBCOEX_500             Customer Exit Correspondenz-IDoc Treasury (MM/FX/DE/SE)     .
IF_EX_SMOD_RSR00004            I EXIT_SAPLRSBBS_001            BW: RRI Field Mapping                                       .
IF_EX_SMOD_RSR00004            I EXIT_SAPLRSBBS_002            BW: RRI Customer Exit Called before Jump into R/3           .
IF_EX_SMOD_SAPLFM71            I EXIT_SAPLFM71_001             Preassign FM Acct Assgmt at Transaction/Component Level     .
IF_EX_SMOD_SAPLFMRI            I EXIT_SAPLFMRI_001             Define Data Compression for FMIFIIT/FMIT                    .
IF_EX_SMOD_SAPLFMRI            I EXIT_SAPLFMRI_002             Account Determination for Figures without Clearing          .
IF_EX_SMOD_SAPLFMRI            I EXIT_SAPLFMRI_003             Fill Customer-Specific Field: FI Documents                  .
IF_EX_SMOD_SAPLFMRI            I EXIT_SAPLFMRI_004             Set CFLEV: Yes or No                                        .
IF_EX_SMOD_TRTMDF01            I GET_DATA_AFTER_UPDATE         Market Data: Price Interface to Read Saved Prices           .
IF_EX_SMOD_TRTMDF01            I MODIFY_DATA_BEFORE_UPDATE     Market Data: Modify Market Data Before Saving in Table      .
IF_EX_SMOD_TRTMDF01            I MODIFY_DATA_BEFORE_UPDATE_MDB MarketData: Price Interface for Market Data Buffer VTB_MARKE.
IF_EX_SMOD_TRTMDF01            I MODIFY_FF_REQUESTS            Market Data: Modification of Request List in RFTBFF01       .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_001             User Exit BAPI Replication of Inbound Deliveries            .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_002             User Exit BAPI Verification of Inbound Delivery             .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_003             User Exit BAPI Replication of Outbound Deliveries           .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_004             User Exit BAPI Verification of Outbound Delivery            .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_009             User Exit BAPI for Changes to Inbound Delivery              .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50I_010             User Exit BAPI for Changes to Outbound Delivery             .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_005             User Exit BAPI Replication of Inbound Deliveries (Exit)     .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_006             User Exit BAPI Verification of Inbound Delivery (Exit)      .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_007             User Exit BAPI Replication of Outbound Deliveries (Exit)    .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_008             User Exit BAPI Verification of Outbound Delivery (Exit)     .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_011             User Exit BAPI for Changes to Inbound Delivery (Exit)       .
IF_EX_SMOD_V50B0001            I EXIT_SAPLV50K_012             User Exit BAPI for Changes to Outbound Delivery (Exit)      .
IF_EX_SMOD_V56LDELI            I EXIT_SAPLV56L_002             Read Delivery Data for Transportation Processing            .
IF_EX_SMOD_VBWC_DCP            I EXIT_SAPLVBWC_001             Control of Decoupling for Distributed Batches               .
IF_EX_SMP_SOURCE_SAVED         I MP_SAVED                      Source saved                                                .
IF_EX_SMUM_ASSIGN_ROLE         I ASSIGN                        Assign Role to User                                         .
IF_EX_SMUM_CHANGE_ROLE         I CHANGE_ROLE                   To change/update a user's role profile                      .
IF_EX_SMUM_USER_CHANGE         I CHANGE                        Change user data from C1 data                               .
IF_EX_SMUM_USER_CREATE         I CREATE                        Create user from C1 data                                    .
IF_EX_SMUM_USER_DELETE         I DELETE                        Lock the user                                               .
IF_EX_SMUM_USR_CHANGE_POST     I CHANGE_POST                   Postprocessing functionality - user change                  .
IF_EX_SMUM_USR_CREATE_POST     I CREATE_POST                   Method for application specific functionality - user create .
IF_EX_SOBL_GOS_BROWSER         I ADD_CMD_HANDLER               Add Instances IF_COMMAND_HANDLER                            .
IF_EX_SOLAR_DOCUMENTS          I SAVE_DOCUMENT                 Document Saved                                              .
IF_EX_SOLAR_DOCUMENT_PRINT     I PRINT_DOCUMENT_WITH_SIGNATURESPrint Document                                              .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I CHECK_FOR_SIGNATURES          Checks whether the Document Version is Signed               .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I SA_DOC_DS_CREATE_AND_SIGN     Start Document Signature                                    .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I SOLAR_DOCTYPE_GLOBAL_CHECK    Check for Global Lock                                       .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I SOLAR_DOCUMENT_FREE           Unbuild Controls                                            .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I SOLAR_DOCUMENT_INSERT_DIALOG_TDialog to Create Documents                                  .
IF_EX_SOLMAN_CALLS             I SOLAR_SHOW_DOCUMENT_SIGNATURESShow Signatures of a Document                               .
IF_EX_SPC_DOCINDEX_CONTROL     I CALC_ITEM_POST_CHECK          Posting Control                                             .
IF_EX_SPC_POSTING_CONTROL      I CALC_ITEM_POST_CHECK          Posting Control                                             .
IF_EX_SPC_SEL_CHECK            I CHECK_CALC_ITEM               Exclusion for Material/Organizational Level Combinations    .
IF_EX_SPC_SEL_CHECK            I FILTER_ORGLEVELS              Filter for Organizational Levels                            .
IF_EX_SPI_TOOL                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers a Reference to a Component Tool                    .
IF_EX_SPP_CHECK_RETPART        I CHECK_RETURNABLE_PART         Returnable parts verification                               .
IF_EX_SRMGS_DOCUMENT           I DELETE_DOCUMENT               Called when document deleted                                .
IF_EX_SRMGS_DOCUMENT2          I DELETE_DOCUMENT               Called when document deleted                                .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_AUTHORIZATION     I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check for Access Authorization                              .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I CLEAR_CACHE                   Delete Cache for Property Values                            .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Deletes All Value Variants of Specified Properties          .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I GET_PROPERTIES                Gets List of Properties of Document                         .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I GET_PROPERTY                  Get an Attribute                                            .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I GET_PROPERTY_DEFINITIONS      Gets Definitions of All Possible Properties                 .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets Properties                                             .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_GDMA_DM_PROP      I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Property                                               .
IF_EX_SRM_AL_OBJ_KEY_C         I GET_OBJ_KEY                   Get the Object Key                                          .
IF_EX_SRM_CALL_HANDLE_EXC      I HANDLE_EXCEPTION_PARA         Exception Handling                                          .
IF_EX_SRM_DOC_ACT_AUTH_C       I CHECK_ACTIVITY_AUTH           check authority of user for the activity specified          .
IF_EX_SRM_KPRO_ARCHIVE_INT     I IS_DOCUMENT_OUTDATED          Check if document has to be archived                        .
IF_EX_SRM_KPRO_ARCHIVE_PRE     I IS_DOCUMENT_OUTDATED          Check if document has to be archived                        .
IF_EX_SRM_SWISSKNIFE_ADDON     I PRINT                         Application Exit Print Attribute                            .
IF_EX_SRM_SWISSKNIFE_ADDON     I PROP_INITIALIZE               Application Exit Attribute                                  .
IF_EX_SRM_SWISSKNIFE_ADDON     I PROP_SHOW_GENERIC_F4          Application Exit for Generic Single F4 Help SwissKnife      .
IF_EX_SRM_SWISSKNIFE_ADDON     I PROP_SHOW_MULTI_F4            Application Exit for Generic Multi F4 Help SwissKnife       .
IF_EX_SRM_WF_PATH_ENH          I FORMAT_PATH_DISPLAY           Output Format for Process Route Display                     .
IF_EX_SRM_WF_PATH_ENH          I MANUAL_ACT_PROC               Enter Media Inconsistency Manually                          .
IF_EX_SRM_WF_PATH_SEARCH       I CHECK_ORG_OBJ                 Check Entered Agent After Every Change                      .
IF_EX_SRM_WF_PATH_SEARCH       I GET_AGENT                     Method BEFORE Resolving Process Route Agent in Workflow     .
IF_EX_SRM_WF_PATH_SEARCH       I ORG_SEARCH_HELP               Method BEFORE Calling Search Help for Process Route Agents  .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I CHECK_INPUT_GR_HEAD           Validation of Entries for Header Goods Receipt/Movement     .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I CHECK_INPUT_GR_ITEM           Validation of Items for Goods Receipt/Movement              .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I CHECK_START_GM_DOC_CANCEL_DLG Validation of Header Data and Items Before Reversal         .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I CHECK_START_GM_DOC_EDIT_DLG   Validation of Header Data and Items Before Main Dialog      .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I FIELD_ATTR_SET_GR_HEAD        Set Field Attributes for Header Data Goods Receipt/Movement .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I FIELD_ATTR_SET_GR_ITEM        Set Field Attributes for Items Goods Receipt/Movement       .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I NEW_FIELD_GR_HEAD             Define New Fields for Header Data Goods Receipt/Movement    .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I NEW_FIELD_GR_ITEM             Define New Fields for Items Goods Receipt/Movement          .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I PROCESSING_BEFORE_POSTING     Enrichment of Material Document Data Before Update          .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I PROCESS_BEFORE_CREATE_GM      Enrich Material Document Data Before Calling BAPI           .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I READ_INPUT_GR_HEAD            Receipt of Entry for Header Goods Receipt/Movement          .
IF_EX_SRS_GR_FIELD             I READ_INPUT_GR_ITEM            Receipt of Ebtry for Items Goods Receipt/Movement           .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I CHECK_INPUT_PDC_HEAD          Validation of Entries for Header Data in Release Monitor    .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I CHECK_INPUT_PDC_ITEM          Validation of Entries for Item Data Release Monitor         .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I FIELD_ATTR_SET_PDC_HEAD       Set Field Attributes for Header Data Release Monitor        .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I FIELD_ATTR_SET_PDC_ITEM       Set Field Attributes Item Data of Release Monitor           .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I NEW_FIELD_PDC_HEAD            Define New Fields for Header Data of Release Monitor        .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I NEW_FIELD_PDC_ITEM            Define New Fields for Item Data in Release Monitor          .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_FIELD            I PROCESSING_BEFORE_POSTING     Enrichment of Material Document Data Before Update          .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_INBOUND       I PDC_GOODMVT_CREAT             Enhancement of Goods Receipt Data from PDC                  .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_MAT_OUT       I FINISH_DATA                   Close Outbound Processing                                   .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_MAT_OUT       I MATERIAL_PREP                 Enhancement Material and EAN                                .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_OUTBOUND      I CUSTOMIZING_PREP              Enhancement Customizing/Business Transaction.               .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_OUTBOUND      I FINISH_DATA                   Close Outbound Processing                                   .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_OUTBOUND      I PLANT_PREP                    Enhancement to Plant                                        .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GM_OUTBOUND      I VENDOR_PREP                   Enhancement to Vendor                                       .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I CUST_GR_PREP                  Enhancement Customizing                                     .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I DELIVERY_GR_PREP              Enhancement to Delivery                                     .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I FINISH_DATA                   Close Outbound Processing                                   .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I HU_GR_PREP                    Enhancement to Handling Unit                                .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I MATDOC_GR_PREP                Enhancement to Material Document                            .
IF_EX_SRS_PDC_GR_OUTBOUND      I PURORDER_GR_PREP              Enhancement to Purchase Order                               .
IF_EX_SRV_BILLING_CHANGE       I SERVICE_BILLING_DATA_CHANGE   Data Influence Billing Service Contracts/-Orders            .
IF_EX_SRV_BILLING_CHANGE       I SRVCONF_BILLING_DATA_CHANGE   Data Influence Billing Service Confirmations                .
IF_EX_SRV_CONF_MOVE_TYPE       I CHANGE_DATA_FOR_GOODS_MM      Data Influence Before Creating Goods Movement               .
IF_EX_SS01_BADI                I METHOD_SS01                   Payment sampling - batching process                         .
IF_EX_SS02_BADI                I METHOD_SS02_CLERK             Add-In logics for supervisor/clerk relation check           .
IF_EX_SS02_BADI                I METHOD_SS02_RULES             Add-In logics for payment statistical sampling rules        .
IF_EX_SS02_BADI_CLERK_CHK      I METHOD_SS02                   Business Add-in for clerk and supervisor relationship chcek .
IF_EX_STEPDATAEXCHANGEMANA     I CHANGE_SCHEMA_LIST            Postprocess Schema List                                     .
IF_EX_STEPDATAEXCHANGEMANA     I DROP_NOT_CHECKED_ORIGINALS    Delete doc. originals that are not checked in from file list.
IF_EX_STEPDATAEXCHANGEMANA     I EXPORT_START_IN_BATCH         Process Processor in Background Job During Export           .
IF_EX_STOREGROUPING            I IS_ACTIVE                     Checks if store grouping is valid                           .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_ASSORTMENT_ASSIGNMENT   Custom check for assortment site assignment                 .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_ASSORTMENT_CREATION     Custom check for assortment refsite creation                .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_ASSORTMENT_UNASSIGN     Custom check for assortment site unassignment               .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_CUSTOM_SITE_MOVE        Custom check for site move from a reference site to another .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_LOGISTIC_ASSIGNMENT     Custom check for logistic data site assignment              .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_LOGISTIC_CREATION       Custom check for logistic data refsite creation             .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_LOGISTIC_UNASSIGN       Custom check for logistic data site unassignment            .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_PURCHASING_ASSIGNMENT   Custom check for purchasing site assignment                 .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_PURCHASING_CREATION     Custom check for purchasing refsite creation                .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHECK_PURCHASING_UNASSIGN     Custom check for purchasing site unassignment               .
IF_EX_STOREGROUP_USER_EXIT     I CHOOSE_TYPE_OF_CHECK          Flag type of check users desires                            .
IF_EX_STOREORDER_POST_PROC     I CALL                          Call                                                        .
IF_EX_STOREORDER_PRE_PROC      I CALL                          Call                                                        .
IF_EX_SURVEY_MERGE             I FILL_MERGE_ADDON              User-defined merge folder                                   .
IF_EX_SUR_STOCK_TRANSF_CK      I SET_SURCHARGES_ACTIVE_OR_NOT  Activate Overhead Calculation or Not                        .
IF_EX_SXBP_USER_EXIT           I DETERMINE_TARGET              Handling of a Server Group                                  .
IF_EX_SXMS_MSG_BACK            I NOTIFY_RESPONSE               Signal that XI response message has arrived                 .
IF_EX_S_TOOL_ACCESS            I CHECK_ACCESS_PERMISSION       Checks Whether Object can be Processed                      .
IF_EX_S_WB_SAVE_TCODE          I CHANGE_AT_SAVE                Call Before Saving Transaction Code                         .
IF_EX_TAANA_VIRTUAL_FIELDS     I VIRT_FIELD_VALUE_DETERMINE    Table Analysis: Determine Value of a Virtual Field          .
IF_EX_TAAN_STXH                I GET_ARCHOBJ                   Determine Archiving Object                                  .
IF_EX_TAX1_XTXIT_SET           I XTXIT_SET                     Determine Tax on Line Basis                                 .
IF_EX_TAX_CONDITIONS           I FILL_KOMK_KOMP                Enhance KOM* with Country-Specific Fields                   .
IF_EX_TAX_CONDITIONS           I PROCESS_TKOMV                 Process TKOMV After Processing                              .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_CUA                        Hide and Display Menu Entries                               .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_DOCUMENT_CHANGE            Changes to all Document Data in PAI of TC                   .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_DOCUMENT_PBO               Changes in PBO                                              .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_HEADER_TEXT_COPY           Copy Header Texts                                           .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_ITEM_COPY                  Copy Customer-Specific Data When Copying an Item            .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_ITEM_CREATION              Further Items When Creating a New Item                      .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_ITEM_TEXT_COPY             Copy Item Text                                              .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_PARTNER_PROCESSING         Customer-Specific Partner Check                             .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_READ                       Transfer Data after Reading the Contract                    .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_STATUS_CHANGE              Check Status Change                                         .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_TC_COPY                    Changes to All Document Data in PAI of TC                   .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_TC_DELETION                At T/C Deletion Process: Switch Physical/Logical Deletion   .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_TC_LIST_PROCESSING         Fill Additional Data In The Trading Contract List           .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I AT_TRANSACTION_END_FCODE      Call a New Transaction when Transaction is Closed           .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I BEFORE_HEADER_MAINTENANCE     Change KOMWBHD KOMWBHK before Maintenance of Header         .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I BEFORE_ITEM_MAINTENANCE       Change KOMWBHD KOMWBHI Before Maintenance of Item           .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Check Header Data                                           .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Check Item Data                                             .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I PROCESS_ORG_DATA_SCREEN       Display Organizational Data                                 .
IF_EX_TC_CHANGE                I SET_DEFAULT_DATA_SCREEN       Screens for Customer Defaults                               .
IF_EX_TFC_CHECK_CAN_START      I CAN_START                     Can this job start?                                         .
IF_EX_TFC_GET_PARENT_ORG       I GET_AUSPRAEG_TEXT             Select Value Text Dependent on Language                     .
IF_EX_TFC_GET_PARENT_ORG       I GET_PARENT_ORG                Determine Value of Parent Org Object                        .
IF_EX_TFC_IS_VISIBLE           I IS_VISIBLE                    Check Whether Task May Start                                .
IF_EX_TFW_DISTRIBUTE           I DISTRIBUTE                    Distribute Changes Relating to Object Instances             .
IF_EX_TFW_MINITP               I NOT_USED_MINITP               Objects Do Not Use Mini-Templates, as Own Data Exists       .
IF_EX_TFW_MINITP               I WHERE_USED_MINITP             Objects to Which a Mini-Template Is Directly Assigned       .
IF_EX_TFW_MINITP_DEL_CHECK     I CHECK_MINITP_DELETE           Check Whether Mini-Template Can Be Deleted                  .
IF_EX_TFW_READ                 I READ                          Read Data by Mini-Template Type and Read Method             .
IF_EX_TFW_SHOW_WHERE_USED      I CALL_WHERE_USED_POPUP         Transfer of Where-Used List for Display in Popup            .
IF_EX_TFW_TEMPLATE             I WHERE_USED_TP                 Objects to Which a Template Is Assigned                     .
IF_EX_TFW_TEMPLATE_UPDATE      I GET_UPDATE_INFO               Pass on Information About Changes to Templates              .
IF_EX_TFW_TP01_DEL_CHECK       I CHECK_TP01_CHANGE             Is the Change Made to the Assignment Allowed?               .
IF_EX_TFW_TP01_DEL_CHECK       I CHECK_TP01_DELETE             May Assignment of Mini-Template to Template Be Deleted?     .
IF_EX_TIM00ABSCOUNTRY_DAY      I CALCULATE_ATTABS_MULT         Calculation of Dynamic Multipliers                          .
IF_EX_TIM00ABSCOUNTRY_DAY      I CLOSE                         Closing Activities After Counting Has Finished              .
IF_EX_TIM00ABSCOUNTRY_DAY      I OPEN                          Initializes Day Processing                                  .
IF_EX_TIM00ABSCOUNTRY_DAY      I REGISTER                      Registers the Country Implementation                        .
IF_EX_TIM00ATTABSCOUNTING      I CALCULATE_ATTABS_MULT         Calculation of dynamic multiplier for hours and days        .
IF_EX_TIM00ATTABSCOUNTING      I CLOSE                         Final activities after counting                             .
IF_EX_TIM00ATTABSCOUNTING      I OPEN                          Initialization of day counting                              .
IF_EX_TIM00ATTABSCOUNTING      I REGISTER                      Registers an implementation                                 .
IF_EX_TOOLBAR_ACL              I MODIFY_TOOLBAR                Modify the toolbar                                          .
IF_EX_TOOLBAR_FUNC_OHFW        I PROCESS                       Processes the toolbar function                              .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCCR_EXIT                    Changes the Amount Information                              .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCHD_BKTXT_EXIT              Changes the Document Header Text                            .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_BLDAT_EXIT              Changes the Document Date                                   .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_EXIT                    Changes the Entire Structure                                .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_GSBER_EXIT              Changes the Business Area                                   .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_HKONT_EXIT              Changes the Account                                         .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_KOSTL_EXIT              Changes the Cost Center                                     .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_KUNNR_EXIT              Changes the Customer Number                                 .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_LANDL_EXIT              Changes the Delivering Country                              .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_LZBKZ_EXIT              Changes the State Central Bank Indicator                    .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_RMVCT_EXIT              Changes the Flow Type                                       .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_SGTXT_EXIT              Changes the Item Text                                       .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_VBUND_EXIT              Changes the Partner Company                                 .
IF_EX_TPM_ACCIF_TRAC           I ACCIT_ZUONR_EXIT              Changes the Assignment Number                               .
IF_EX_TPM_AMORTIZATION_CAL     I CHANGE_AMORTIZATION           Changes the Amortization Amounts                            .
IF_EX_TPM_CASHFLOW_CALC        I MODIFY_UPDATE_TYPE            Changed Update Type for Accrued Interest Flows              .
IF_EX_TPM_CORPORATE_ACTION     I ADJUST_CA_FLOWS               Adjustment of Flows to Be Transferred                       .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I BLOCK_PAYMENT                 Blocks a Payment                                            .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I CANCEL_PAYMENT                Reverses a Payment                                          .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I CREATE_PAYMENT                Generates a Payment                                         .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I DISPLAY_PAYMENT               Displays Payment                                            .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I GET_PAYMENT_STATUS            Gets the Status of a Payment                                .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I IS_RELEVANT                   Payment Should Be Made via External Payment Program         .
IF_EX_TPM_EXT_PAYMENT_TRPR     I RELEASE_PAYMENT               Releases a Payment                                          .
IF_EX_TPM_INCOMING_PAYMENT     I EXECUTE                       Execute Enhancement                                         .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I CHANGE_ACCOUNT_SYMBOL_ID      Changes the ID of New Account Symbols                       .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I CHANGE_DERIVATION_STEP_ID     Changes the ID of Migrated Derivations Steps                .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I CHANGE_GROUPING_ID            Changes the ID of Migrated Grouping Characteristics         .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I CHANGE_POSTING_RULE_ID        Changes the ID of New Posting Specifications                .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I CHANGE_UPDATE_TYPE            Changes the Update Type                                     .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I MAP_SL_FIELDS                 Transfers Information from Special Ledgers                  .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I SET_POSTING_DATES             Changes the Posting Data for Position Transfer Postings     .
IF_EX_TPM_MIGRATION_TRAC       I TRANSLATE_FIELDVALUE          Translates an Acct Assign. Ref. Determination Field Value   .
IF_EX_TPM_PAYREQIF_TRPR        I PAYRQ_DATA_MEDIUM_X_EXIT      Changes the Fields for Data Medium Exchange                 .
IF_EX_TPM_PAYREQIF_TRPR        I PAYRQ_SGTXT_EXIT              Changes the Position Text                                   .
IF_EX_TPM_PAYREQIF_TRPR        I PAYRQ_SWTXT_EXIT              Changes the SWIFT Text                                      .
IF_EX_TPM_PAYREQIF_TRPR        I PAYRQ_URGENT_EXIT             Changes the Indicator for Urgent Payment                    .
IF_EX_TPM_POS_IND_TRAC         I CHANGE                        Changes Acct Assignment Ref. of Subledger Position Indicator.
IF_EX_TPM_POS_IND_TRAC         I SUPPRESS_PERS_FOR_PLANNED_REC Deactivate Saving Account Assignment Ref.for Planned Flows  .
IF_EX_TPM_POS_IND_TRL          I CHANGE                        Changes the Subledger Position Indicator Attributes         .
IF_EX_TPM_POS_IND_TRS          I CHANGE                        Changes the Securities Account Position Indicator Attributes.
IF_EX_TPM_POS_MAN_PROC_TRL     I CHANGE_POS_MAN_PROC           Changes the Position Management Procedure                   .
IF_EX_TPM_PRICE_INDEX          I ADJUST_INDEX_VALUE            Adjust Interpolated Value (Central)                         .
IF_EX_TPM_PRICE_INDEX          I ADJUST_VALUE_DATE             Adjust Fixing Date (Central)                                .
IF_EX_TPM_PRICE_INDEX          I ADJ_VALUE_DATE_FOR_COND_FLOW  Adjust Fixing Date for Condition Flows                      .
IF_EX_TPM_PRICE_INDEX          I ADJ_VALUE_DATE_FOR_DEAL_FLOW  Adjust Fixing Date for Main Transaction Flow                .
IF_EX_TPM_SECACCTRANS          I EXECUTE                       Execute Enhancement                                         .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Check whether additional data necessary                     .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_CHANGED                  Data Changed                                                .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_CHECK                    Check Data                                                  .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_DELETE                   Delete Data                                                 .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_EDIT                     Change Additional Data                                      .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_RESTORE                  Recover Data                                                .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I DATA_SAVE                     Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_DATA         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Local Structures / Variables                     .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_PRICING      I CALCULATE_FROM_YIELD          Own Costing                                                 .
IF_EX_TPM_SEC_ADD_PRICING      I CHECK_ACTIVE                  Check Whether Own Costing Available                         .
IF_EX_TPM_TRL_MANIPULATE       I CHANGE_TITLE_VALUATION        For Changes to Security Valuation Amounts                   .
IF_EX_TPM_TRL_MANIPULATE       I MANIPULATE_CALC_BASIS         For Manipulating Calculation Basis of a Valuation Step      .
IF_EX_TPM_TRL_MANIPULATE       I MANIPULATE_DERIVED_FLOWS      For Manipulating Flows from Derived Business Transactions   .
IF_EX_TPM_TRL_MANIPULATE       I MANIPULATE_VALUATION_FLOWS    For Manipulating Flows from Valuations                      .
IF_EX_TPM_VALUATION_PRICE      I GET_SEC_PRICE_FOR_SEC_ACCOUNT Read Security Price on Key Date                             .
IF_EX_TRAININGTYPE_ADV_C       I GET_LIST                      Generate List of Course Types                               .
IF_EX_TRANSPORT_CHAIN_E        I CHECK_TRANSP_CHAIN            Check the Transportation Chain                              .
IF_EX_TRANSPORT_CHAIN_E        I DETERMINE_TRANSP_CHAIN        Determine the Transportation Chain                          .
IF_EX_TRIGGER_EXECUTED         I TRIGGER_EXECUTED              Action Has Been Executed                                    .
IF_EX_TRIGGER_EXECUTED         I TRIGGER_EXECUTED_IN_REPORT    Action Has Been Executed in Processing Report               .
IF_EX_TRIP_APPROVAL            I APPROVE_TRIP                  Automatic Trip Approval  Yes/No                             .
IF_EX_TRIP_EXCEL_SHEET         I SEND_MACRO_CALL               Call Excel Macro                                            .
IF_EX_TRIP_IMP_EXP             I RESTRICT_TRAVEL_RANGE         Import and Edit Trips Only from Certain Date                .
IF_EX_TRIP_IMP_EXP             I RESTRICT_TRIPS_IN_RANGE       Do Not Display All Imported Trips                           .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EXA706K                       User Form after reading T706K                               .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EXB706K                       User Form before reading T706K                              .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EX_SGTXT                      User form for changing segment text and assignment          .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EX_ZWEP                       Line-based changes to booking date                          .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EX_ZWEP_ACCOUNT1              Line-based change to symb.acc.assignment 1st booking T706K  .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EX_ZWEP_ACCOUNT2              Line-based change to symb.acc.assignment 2nd booking T706K  .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I EX_ZWEP_COMPLETE              Changes to complete booking data before transfer to AC      .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I FILL_EXT_RAWDATA              Fill table CUSTOMER_EXTENSION in RPRPOSTD                   .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I MODIFY_PTRV_DOC_HD            Modify header (PTRV_DOC_HD) in day book                     .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I MODIFY_PTRV_DOC_IT            Modify line items (PTRV_DOC_IT) in day book                 .
IF_EX_TRIP_POST_FI             I MODIFY_PTRV_DOC_TAX           Modify tax items (PTRV_DOC_TAX) in day book                 .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHANGE_DETACHED_RECS          Change Split Documents                                      .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHANGE_DROP_DOWN_LIST         Change List of Expense Types Displayed                      .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHANGE_PICTURE                Change Screen Displayed                                     .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHANGE_SCREEN_SET             Change Screen Group                                         .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHANGE_SPLIT_REC              Change Itemized Receipt                                     .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I CHECK_REST_AMOUNT             Check Remaining Amount on Original Receipt                  .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECEIPT_WIZARD      I FORCE_SPLIT_CORRECTION        Enter Price Per Day Manually on "Divide Receipt" Screen     .
IF_EX_TRIP_RECURRENT_DEST      I SET_DIFFERENT_WAGETYPE        Assign Portion of Trip to Different Wage Type               .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I AFTER_ADD_RECEIPT             Time After Adding a Travel Expense Receipt                  .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I AFTER_GET_CUSTOMIZING         Time After Reading Customizing Information                  .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I AFTER_MODIFY_TRIP             Time After Changing/Deleting or Additing a Trip             .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I AFTER_TRIP_GET_LIST           Time After Filling Trip List with Trip Number and Action    .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I BEFORE_ADD_RECEIPT            Time After Adding a Travel Expense Receipt                  .
IF_EX_TRIP_WAF_INTERFACE       I BEFORE_MODIFY_TRIP            Time After Changing/Deleting/Adding a Trip                  .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_ADDRESSES       I USER_EXIT_ADDRESSES           Retrieve Table with Predefined Addresses                    .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_ADVANCES           Edit All Advances                                           .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_CHANGES            Trip Changes                                                .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_DEDUCTIONS         Edit All Deductions                                         .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_GENERAL_DATA       General Information and Period Data of a Trip               .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_ITINERARY          Edit All Destinations and Cost Distribution Destinations    .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_ITIN_COSTS_SPLIT   Cost Apportionment Destinations                             .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_ADVANCES   Edit Individual Advance                                     .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_CCC_RECEIPTEdit Individual Credit Card Receipt                         .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_DEDUCTIONS Edit Individual Deduction                                   .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_ITINERARY  Edit Individual Destination and Cost Distrib. Destinations  .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_MILEAGE    Edit Individual Leg of Trip and Cost Distribution Mileage   .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_LINE_OF_RECEIPTS   Edit Individual Receipt and Cost Distribution Receipts      .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_MILEAGE            Edit All Legs of Trip and Cost Distribution Mileage         .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_MILE_COSTS_SPLIT   Cost Distribution: Miles/Kilometers                         .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_RECEIPTS           Edit All Receipts and Cost Distribution Receipts            .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_RECE_COSTS_SPLIT   Cost Distribution for Receipts                              .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_TEXT               General Texts of Trip                                       .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CHECK           I USER_CHECK_TRIP_COSTS_SPLIT   Cost Distribution of Trip                                   .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_CUSTOMIZING     I USER_EXIT_CUSTOMIZING         Retrieve Customizing Tables                                 .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_NUMBER          I USER_EXIT_NUMBER_EXTERNAL     Change External Number Range Interval                       .
IF_EX_TRIP_WEB_NUMBER          I USER_EXIT_NUMBER_INTERNAL     Change Internal Number Range Interval                       .
IF_EX_TRV_DEFAULT_VALUES       I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Default Values                                        .
IF_EX_TRV_DEFAULT_VALUES       I GET_VALUES                    Get Default Values for Public Sector GB from Infotype 0222  .
IF_EX_TR_GET_ACCNT_ASSIGN      I GET_ACCNT_ASSIGN              Determine FM Acc. Assignmt frm Acc. Assignmt Block in RWIN  .
IF_EX_TTE_BPARTNER             I ATTRIBUTE_CONVERSION          Attribute Conversion                                        .
IF_EX_TTE_BPARTNER             I F4_HELP                       Context Sensitive F4 Help                                   .
IF_EX_TTE_BPARTNER             I FIELD_CHECK                   Field Check                                                 .
IF_EX_TTE_BPARTNER             I SHORT_TEXT_RETRIEVAL          Short Text Determination                                    .
IF_EX_TTE_CUST_CHECK           I ADDITIONAL_TTE_CHECKS         Additional checks of TTE-Customizing                        .
IF_EX_TTE_CUST_IMPORT          I FILL_TABLES                   Fill given tables from external systems to update TTE tables.
IF_EX_TTE_DT_CHECK             I EXTRAS                        List of transaction codes for "Extras" function             .
IF_EX_TTE_DT_CHECK             I USAGE_CHECK                   Check if decision tree is used                              .
IF_EX_TTE_DT_NODE_CHECK        I RESULT_CHECK                  Check result node                                           .
IF_EX_TTE_DT_NODE_CHECK        I VALID_FROM_DATE_CHECK         Check valid-from date                                       .
IF_EX_TTE_TAXJURCODE           I F4_HELP                       Context Sensitive F4 Help                                   .
IF_EX_TTE_TAXJURCODE           I FIELD_CHECK                   Field Check                                                 .
IF_EX_TTE_TAXJURCODE           I SHORT_TEXT_RETRIEVAL          Short Text Determination                                    .
IF_EX_TXJCD_EXTN               I TXJCD_CHANGE_ALLOWED          Allow Change to Jurisdiction Code                           .
IF_EX_UA_INV_GRIR_CLEARING     I FILTER                        Filter Fin Objects                                          .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I FILTER_FIN_OBJECTS            Filter FIN Object Instances                                 .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I GET_LOG                       Get Results of Processing Block                             .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I POST                          Update                                                      .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I PREPARE                       Preparation                                                 .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I PROCESS_DATA                  Check and Prepare Data                                      .
IF_EX_UA_INV_REVALUATION       I PROCESS_DATA_AT_END           Postprocess Result                                          .
IF_EX_UA_INV_TP_READ           I CONSTRUCT_ELEMENTS            Read Cost Component Group                                   .
IF_EX_UA_INV_TP_READ           I READ_TP_DATA                  Read Plan/Target Data CO Object R/3                         .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I COST_DISTRIBUTION             Cost Distribution Based on Application-Specific Algorithm   .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I CREATE_DISPLAY_HEADER         Format Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I DISTRIBUTION_BADI             Call Customer BADI                                          .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I ENHANCE_SETTLEMENT_RULE       Enrich Sender/Receiver Before Cost Distribution             .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I GET_DEFAULT_RULE              Default Generation of Settlement Rule When Creating         .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I GET_RULE_AT_DISTRIBUTION      Generate Receiver Rules Before Cost Distribution            .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I TRANSLATE_AFTER_DISTRIBUTION  Transformation of Results Data After Distribution           .
IF_EX_UA_INV_WIP_DISTRIBUT     I TRANSLATE_BEFORE_DISTRIBUTION Transformation of Basic Data Before Distribution            .
IF_EX_UA_UPLOAD_EXPLLIST       I MODIFY_DATA                   Extend Itemizations                                         .
IF_EX_UA_UPLOAD_QTY_STRUCT     I MODIFY_DATA                   Extend Quantity Structure                                   .
IF_EX_UA_UPLOAD_SURCHARGE      I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify Surcharge Values                                     .
IF_EX_UA_UPLOAD_TEMPLATE       I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify Template Values                                      .
IF_EX_UA_UPLOAD_XML            I MODIFY_DATA                   Extend XML                                                  .
IF_EX_UBC_CE_TRANSFER          I TRANSFER                      Transfer Cost Events                                        .
IF_EX_UBC_CSP_WF_STRAT         I GET_STRATEGY                  Get Strategy for Workflow                                   .
IF_EX_UC_CUSTOM_TASK           I EXECUTE                       Task Execution                                              .
IF_EX_UC_CUSTOM_TASK           I EXECUTE_FINAL                 End Processing of Task Execution                            .
IF_EX_UC_TASK_CUSTOM           I EXECUTE                       Task Execution                                              .
IF_EX_UC_TASK_CUSTOM           I EXECUTE_FINAL                 End Processing of Task Execution                            .
IF_EX_UDM_ADD_DATA_PPF_C       I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA           Delivers additional data for correspondence                 .
IF_EX_UDM_BASIS_RULE           I CHECK_SELOPTS                 Check Entries for Consistence                               .
IF_EX_UDM_BASIS_RULE           I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Basic Rule of Business Partner                     .
IF_EX_UDM_BASIS_RULE           I GET_TEXT                      Determine Text for Basic Rule                               .
IF_EX_UDM_BP_PROFILE_C         I DETERMINE_PROFILE             Determine Collection Profile to Be Entered                  .
IF_EX_UDM_CCT_DEFAULT          I GET_CCT_DEFAULT_NOTE          Get Standard Note                                           .
IF_EX_UDM_CCT_DEFAULT          I GET_CCT_DURATION_PROPERTY     Duration: Change and Default Field Properties               .
IF_EX_UDM_CHNG_SGMT_DATA_C     I DETERMINE_SEGMENT_DATA        Determine Group and Specialist to Be Entered                .
IF_EX_UDM_LOC_CHG_ATTR_S       I CHECK_CHG_POSSIBLE            Check whether Attribute Change Is Possible                  .
IF_EX_UDM_LOC_CHG_ATTR_S       I CHECK_VALUE                   Input Value Is Being Checked                                .
IF_EX_UDM_LOC_CHG_ATTR_S       I GET_HELP_OBJECT               Delivers Search Help Object                                 .
IF_EX_UDM_LOC_MASSACT_C        I EXECUTE_ACTIVITY              The additional activities were executed                     .
IF_EX_UDM_LOC_MASSACT_C        I GET_ACTIVITIES                Provides Table of Additional Activities                     .
IF_EX_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN_S       I DELETE_RUN                    Run will be deleted                                         .
IF_EX_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN_S       I INTERVAL_PROCESSING           Exit Processing of Interval                                 .
IF_EX_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN_S       I POST_PARALLEL_PROCESSING      Exit after Parallel Processing                              .
IF_EX_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN_S       I PRE_PARALLEL_PROCESSING       Exit before Parallel Processing                             .
IF_EX_UDM_PARTNER_PPF_C        I GET_PARTNER                   Partner Determination for PPF Connection                    .
IF_EX_UDM_PARTNER_PPF_S        I GET_PARTNER                   Partner Determination for PPF Connection                    .
IF_EX_UDM_RSM_DEFAULT          I UDM_RSM_CREATE_INIT           Creation of Resubmission: Field Properties and Values       .
IF_EX_UDM_RSM_DEFAULT          I UDM_RSM_MODIFY_INIT           Changing Resubmission: Field Properties                     .
IF_EX_UDM_RULE                 I GET_TEXT                      Text for Prerequisite, Condition (Alternative to Standard)  .
IF_EX_UDM_STORE_EVENTS_C       I RAISE_EVENTS                  Decision for Triggering Events                              .
IF_EX_UDM_STORE_EVENTS_S       I RAISE_EVENTS                  Decision for Triggering Events                              .
IF_EX_UDM_WL_ITEM_CREATE_C     I BEFORE_DB_INSERT              Before Worklist Item Saved                                  .
IF_EX_UG_MD_SUB_OBJECT         I GET_SUB_OBJECT                Get application specific sub-objects                        .
IF_EX_UI_LISTS_EXT             I CHECK_FCODE_COELIST           Toolbar of Cost Element List                                .
IF_EX_UI_LISTS_EXT             I EXCLUDE_FCODE_100X_SET        Status of Dynpro 100X                                       .
IF_EX_UKM_BLACKWHITE_LIST      I IS_ON_BLACK_LIST              Entry Exists in Black List                                  .
IF_EX_UKM_BLACKWHITE_LIST      I IS_ON_WHITE_LIST              Entry Exists in White List                                  .
IF_EX_UKM_BP_ADD_FIELDS        I FILL_ADD_INFOS                Fill Table UKM_TS_ADD_INFO                                  .
IF_EX_UKM_BP_ADD_FIELDS        I FILL_FIELDS                   Fill Structure UKM_S_BP_CUSTOMER_EXTENSION                  .
IF_EX_UKM_BP_ADD_FIELDS        I SAVE_ADD_INFOS                Resave Table UKM_TS_ADD_INFO                                .
IF_EX_UKM_CHECK_STEP           I CHECK_STEP                    Execute Individual Check Step                               .
IF_EX_UKM_COMMITMENT_PUSH      I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_EX_UKM_CONV_TO_PARTNER      I CONVERT                       Conversion of Partner Number                                .
IF_EX_UKM_CONV_TO_PARTNER      I PREREAD                       Initial Read before Preparation of Individual Conversions   .
IF_EX_UKM_CONV_TO_PARTNER_PI   I CONVERT                       Conversion of Partner Number                                .
IF_EX_UKM_CONV_TO_PARTNER_PI   I PREREAD                       Preread for Preparation of Individual Conversions           .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_CHECK         I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_CHECK         I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface from SAP Credit Management to XI         .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I CHECK_EXT_INFO                Additional Evaluations of Answer                            .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I CONVERT_OUTBOUND_RATING       SAP Credit Management -" XI: Adjust Outgoing Rating         .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I FILL_QUERY                    Fill Request Parameters                                     .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I GRADE_METHOD_TO_DESCRIPTION   Set Description for Valuation Method (for Doc. Storage)     .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I HANDLE_REQUEST_FAILED         In case of error, add log                                   .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I HANDLE_REQUEST_FAILED2        In case of error, set scoring                               .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I MONITOR_CHECK_RESPONSE        Additional Evaluations of Answer                            .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I MONITOR_FILL_QUERY            Change Request Parameters                                   .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I MONITOR_READ_NOTIFICATION     Evaluate Inbound Notification                               .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I MONITOR_READ_RESPONSE         Evaluate Answer                                             .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I READ_RESPONSE                 Evaluate Answer                                             .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I SEARCH_ID_FILL_QUERY          Change Request Parameters                                   .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO          I SEARCH_ID_READ_RESPONSE       Evaluate Answer                                             .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO_SEARCH   I CHANGE_SEARCH_COMPONENT       Activate/Deactivate Search Fields                           .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO_SEARCH   I CHANGE_SEARCH_DATA            Adjust Field Content of Search                              .
IF_EX_UKM_CREDIT_INFO_SEARCH   I CHANGE_SEARCH_SCREEN          Change Position on Search Screen                            .
IF_EX_UKM_EVENTING             I HANDLE_EVENT                  Event Handling                                              .
IF_EX_UKM_EVENTING             I HANDLE_PROCESS_EXCEPTION      Handle Exceptions Occurring in Follow-On Processes          .
IF_EX_UKM_EVENT_PUBLISHER      I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface from SAP Credit Management to XI         .
IF_EX_UKM_EV_FORMULA           I ADD_FIELDS                    Add Customer-Defined Parameters                             .
IF_EX_UKM_EV_FORMULA           I FILL_FIELD                    Evaluate Customer-Defined Parameters                        .
IF_EX_UKM_ITEMS_FILL           I FILL_FIELDS                   Fields for the Interface for the Liability Update           .
IF_EX_UKM_MASSDATA_SELECT      I CHECK_ACCOUNTS                Exclude Credit Accounts from Selection                      .
IF_EX_UKM_MASSDATA_SELECT      I CHECK_PARTNER                 Exclude Business Partners from Selection                    .
IF_EX_UKM_PROCESSES            I IS_EVENT_ACTIVE               Checks whether an event is to be handled internally/external.
IF_EX_UKM_PROCESSES            I MODIFY_CONSECUTIVE_PROCESSES  Changes or Supplements the Number of Follow-On Processes    .
IF_EX_UKM_R3_ACTIVATE          I SET_ACTIVE                    Activates Credit Management                                 .
IF_EX_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH          I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_EX_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH          I CONVERT_INBOUND_2             Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_EX_UMB_AUTHORITY            I CHECK_ACTVT                   Checks Activity                                             .
IF_EX_UMB_AUTHORITY            I CHECK_SCARD                   Checks Scorecard Authorization                              .
IF_EX_UMB_AUTHORITY            I CHECK_SCARD_ELEMENT           Checks Element Authorization                                .
IF_EX_UMB_AUTHORITY            I CHECK_SCARD_ELEMENT_INDEP     Checks Element Authorization Independently of Scorecard     .
IF_EX_UMB_AUTHORITY            I CHECK_SCARD_HIERARCHY         Checks Scorecard Hierarchy Authorization                    .
IF_EX_UMB_LOCK                 I CHECK_OBJECTS_KEYS            BSC Wizard: Check Object Keys                               .
IF_EX_UMB_LOCK                 I CHECK_OBJECTS_KEYS_SAPGUI     SAPGUI: Check Object Keys                                   .
IF_EX_UMB_LOCK                 I INSERT_OBJECTS_KEYS_SAPGUI    SAPGUI: Insert Object Keys                                  .
IF_EX_UMB_VISIBILITY           I FILTER_OBJECTIVES             Filter Objectives                                           .
IF_EX_UMB_VISIBILITY           I FILTER_PERSPECTIVES           Filter Perspectives                                         .
IF_EX_UMB_VISIBILITY           I FILTER_STRATEGIES             Filter Strategies                                           .
IF_EX_UPB_SY_HIERARCHY         I CREATE_HIERARCHY              Create Target Group Hierarchy                               .
IF_EX_UPS_ADDONS               I RUPSSEND_DONE                 Is Called After the IDOCs Are Sent                          .
IF_EX_UPS_ADDONS_I             I RUPSSEND_DONE                 Is Called After the IDOCs Are Sent                          .
IF_EX_UPS_NAME_RESOLVE         I RESOLVE                       Name Resolve                                                .
IF_EX_UPS_OBJECT_SERVICE       I UPSMAS_CREATE                 Exit for Completion in IDOC Organization                    .
IF_EX_UPS_OBJECT_SERVICE_I     I UPSMAS_CREATE                 Exit for Completion in IDOC Organization                    .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_CELL_UPDATES            Layout Calculations                                         .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_HTML_DOCUMENT           Change HTML Document                                        .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_KF_SCHEME               Change Key Figures Scheme                                   .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_LEAD_COLS               Change Lead Columns                                         .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_PLAN_DATA               Change Plan Data                                            .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I ADOPT_XML_DOCUMENT            Change XML Tree                                             .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I FINALIZE                      Close Date                                                  .
IF_EX_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER        I INITIALIZE                    Preparation                                                 .
IF_EX_UPX_RESP_SOURCE          I DIMENSION                     List Characteristics that Define Responsibilities           .
IF_EX_UPX_RESP_SOURCE          I FETCH_NEXT                    Get next object                                             .
IF_EX_UPX_RESP_SOURCE          I MOVE_FIRST                    Pointer to First Object                                     .
IF_EX_UPX_RESP_SOURCE          I NEXT_EXISTS                   Is there a next object?                                     .
IF_EX_UPX_RESP_SOURCE          I REGISTER                      Register BAdI                                               .
IF_EX_UR_REALIGNMENT_1         I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Check for a Realignment Run                   .
IF_EX_UR_REALIGNMENT_1         I EXECUTE_METHOD                Method Execution of an External Method                      .
IF_EX_UR_REALIGNMENT_1         I SET_SOURCE_SYSTEM_INFO        Fetch Informatoin for Source System ID                      .
IF_EX_UR_REALIGNMENT_1         I VALUE_REQUEST_FOR_METHODS     F4 Help for Exernal Methods                                 .
IF_EX_UWS_SURVEY_COCKPIT       I SET_HEADER                    Copy Mail Header                                            .
IF_EX_UWS_SURVEY_VAL           I VALIDATE_QUESTIONNAIRE        Validation of a Questionnaire                               .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I EXTERNAL_OPERATION_VALUATION  Valuation of F Items                                        .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I EXTERNAL_SERVICE_VALUATION    Valuation of D and N Items                                  .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I INTERNAL_ACTIVITY_VALUATION   Valuation of E Items                                        .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I MAKE_TO_ORDER_VALUATION       Valuation of Make-to-Order Inventories (SOBKZ = E or Q)     .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I MATERIAL_COSTS_SPLIT_READ     Determine Cost Apportionment for Co-Products                .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I MATERIAL_VALUATION            Valuation of Materials                                      .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I OTHER_ITEM_VALUATION          Valuation of All Unknown Item Categories                    .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I PLAN_SURCHARGE_GENERATE       As Replacement for Overhead Processor                       .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I PROCESS_VALUATION             Valuation of P and X Items                                  .
IF_EX_VALUATION_CK             I SUBCONTRACTING_VALUATION      Valuation of L Items                                        .
IF_EX_VBDOCUBATCH              I BATCH_MASTER_CREATE           Change Setting 'Create Batch Master'                        .
IF_EX_VBDOCUBATCH              I BATCH_NUMBER_CHECK            Check Documentary Batch Number                              .
IF_EX_VBDOCUBATCH              I DOCUBATCHES_PRELOAD           Preload Documentary Batches                                 .
IF_EX_VBDOCUBATCH              I PROCESS_CHANGE                Change Settings of the Process Steps                        .
IF_EX_VBDOCUBATCH              I PRODUCT_CHANGE                Change Material Settings                                    .
IF_EX_VBOB_DET_ORIG_BATCH      I DET_ORIGINAL_BATCH_FROM_BATCH Determine Original Batch from Stock Batch                   .
IF_EX_VBOB_INHERIT             I INHERIT_ORIGINAL_BATCH        Determine original batches that can be inherited            .
IF_EX_VBX_SO_SEL_CRITERIA      I MODE_SET                      Set Mode: Batch Determination or Selection Criteria         .
IF_EX_VB_BD_SELECTION          I PRESELECT_BATCHES             Preseletion of Batches                                      .
IF_EX_VB_BD_SELECTION          I PRESELECT_STOCKS              Preseletion of Batch Stock Records                          .
IF_EX_VB_GET_EXT_BATCHES       I GET_BATCH_USAGE_A             Determine Batch Usage for Order                             .
IF_EX_VB_GET_EXT_BATCHES       I GET_BATCH_USAGE_B             Determine Batch Usage for Purchase Order                    .
IF_EX_VB_GET_EXT_BATCHES       I GET_BATCH_USAGE_C             Determine Batch Usage for Batch                             .
IF_EX_VB_GET_POS_PLANT         I GET_PLANT                     Determine Plant for Batch Where-Used List                   .
IF_EX_VB_SLED_MANAGEMENT       I MAINTAIN_SLED_PARAMETERS      Change Parameters of Minimum Shelf Life Processing          .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADDRSCR_CHG       I GET_FILTERVALUE_ADDR_SUBSCREENDetermination of Filter Value for BAS Subscreen             .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADDRSCR_CHG       I GET_LFA1_ADDITIONAL_DATA      Copy Additional LFA1 Values from BAS Screen                 .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADDRSCR_CHG       I SET_LFA1_ADDITIONAL_DATA      Transfer Additional LFA1 Values on BAS Screen               .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I BUILD_TEXT_FOR_CHANGE_DETAIL  Builds Text Line for Details of Field Change                .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I CHECK_ACCOUNT_NUMBER          Check Vendor Number if External Number Assignment           .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I CHECK_ADD_ON_ACTIVE           Check Whether Add-On Connection Should Be Activated         .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I CHECK_ALL_DATA                Final Checks                                                .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Check whether Data Changed Outside of Standard              .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I GET_CHANGEDOCS_FOR_OWN_TABLES Read Change Documents for Own Tables                        .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I INITIALIZE_ADD_ON_DATA        Initialization of Add-On Work Structures                    .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I MODIFY_ACCOUNT_NUMBER         Edit Vendor Number if Internal Number Assignment            .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I PRESET_VALUES_CCODE           Default LFB1 Dependent on General Data                      .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I PRESET_VALUES_PORG            Default LFM1 Dependent on General Data                      .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I PRESET_VALUES_PORG_ALTERNATIVEDefault LFM2 Dependent on General Data                      .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I READ_ADD_ON_DATA              Read Add-On Data                                            .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I SAVE_DATA                     Save Data Outside Standard                                  .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA          I SET_USER_INPUTS               Transfer of User-Inputs to ADD-ON                           .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I CHECK_DATA_ROW                Checks a Data Row                                           .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I FILL_ALE_SEGMENTS_OWN_DATA    Fill ALE Segments in ALE Outbound Processing                .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I FILL_BI_TABLE_WITH_OWN_SEGMENTFill Batch Input Table from Own Segment (ALE Inbound Proc.) .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I FILL_FT_TABLE_USING_DATA_ROWS Fills FT Table (Add-On Part) with Values From Data Rows     .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I MODIFY_BI_STRUCT_FROM_STD_SEG Change BI Structure from Standard Segment                   .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I PASS_NON_STANDARD_SEGMENT     Pass On Customer-Defined Segments (ALE Inbound Processing)  .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_BI       I PROCESS_ALE_OWN_CHANGE_POINTEREvaluate Own Change Pointer                                 .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I GET_DATA                      Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I GET_FIELDNAME_FOR_CHANGEDOC   Transfer Field Name for Change Document Display             .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I GET_TAXI_SCREEN               Determine Screen for Tabs                                   .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I SET_DATA                      Data Transfer                                               .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I SET_FCODE                     Transfer Function Codes to Add-On                           .
IF_EX_VENDOR_ADD_DATA_CS       I SUPPRESS_TAXI_TABSTRIPS       Hide Add-On Tab Pages                                       .
IF_EX_VENDOR_EXTENSION_CHECK   I CHECK                         Integrity Check and Vendor Data Mapping                     .
IF_EX_VENDOR_EXTENSION_COMPLET I COMPLETE                      Data Completion                                             .
IF_EX_VENDOR_EXTENSION_INITIAL I INITIALIZE                    Data Initialization                                         .
IF_EX_VENDOR_EXTENSION_OUT     I ECC_TO_EXTERN                 Data Mapping of ECC Tables to Complex Structure             .
IF_EX_VENDOR_EXTENSION_UPDATE  I UPDATE_MODULES                Data Update                                                 .
IF_EX_VENDOR_FIELDACTIVE       I CHANGE_FIELDSTATUS_CARCONF    Activate CARRIER_CONF Field                                 .
IF_EX_VENDOR_FIELDSTATUS       I GET_FIELDSTATUS_LIST          Import List of New Field Statuses                           .
IF_EX_VIM_ALS_BADI             I ENABLE_ALS                    Check ALS Status                                            .
IF_EX_VIM_ALS_BADI             I GET_ALS_LANGUAGES             Get the ALS language list                                   .
IF_EX_VLC_BW_INTEGRATOR        I PREPARE_DOCLINK               Extract document links                                      .
IF_EX_VLC_CALL_CONFIG          I ACTIVATE_FLAG                 Set the flag value to call other methods.                   .
IF_EX_VLC_CALL_CONFIG          I EXCHANGE_DATA                 Method to send and recieve the configuration                .
IF_EX_VLC_CALL_CONFIG          I GET_DATA                      Method to retrieve the data from configurator               .
IF_EX_VLC_CALL_CONFIG          I SET_SCREENNUMBER              Retrieve the screenprogram and -number for the configurator .
IF_EX_VLC_CHECK_AUTHROLE       I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Enhance authority check                                     .
IF_EX_VLC_CHECK_AUTHROLE       I USER_ROLE_MAPPING             Enhance veloru (VMS user to role mapping)                   .
IF_EX_VLC_CPGM_EXECUTE         I MATERIAL_MAINTAIN_DARK        Changing data before calling material_maintain_dark         .
IF_EX_VLC_CUOR_EXECUTE         I PLANT_DETERMINATION           Retrieval of plant that has been determined by Salesorder   .
IF_EX_VLC_DETERMINE_CONTRL     I FORCE_REDETERMINATION         Force a redetermination of the primary/secondary control    .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ACTION       I CHANGE_MESSAGES               Änderung von Meldungsnummern                                .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I COPY_CONFIGURATION            Kopieren der Fahrzeugkonfiguration in die Auftragskonfig.   .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I FURTHER_ACTIONS               Weitere Aktionen für die Zuordnung                          .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I MATCHING_CRITERIA             Bestimmung der übereinstimmenden Kriterien für Zuordnung    .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I SALES_DOCS_SEARCH             To influence the selection criteria                         .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I SALES_DOCS_WITH_SCREEN        To decide on default selection pop-up to be shown or not    .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I SORT_SALES_DOCS               Sortieren der ermittelten Verkaufsbelege                    .
IF_EX_VLC_EXECUTE_ASSIGNMT     I SORT_VEHICLES                 Sortieren der ermittelten Fahrzeuge                         .
IF_EX_VLC_IPC_SELECT           I SELECT_IPC                    Method for setting flag to select IPC                       .
IF_EX_VLC_OVERVIEW_TREE        I ADD_NODES                     Add nodes to the overview tree                              .
IF_EX_VLC_OVERVIEW_TREE        I REGISTER_EVENTS               Register other events in the overview tree                  .
IF_EX_VLC_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS     I CHANGE_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS       Filter/Influence the list of possible actions               .
IF_EX_VLC_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS     I EXCLUDE_GENERIC_ACTIONS       If the matrix is not set, no actions starting from *        .
IF_EX_VLC_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS     I EXCLUDE_SPECIFIC_CONTROLS     Exclude a list of controls from the action determination    .
IF_EX_VLC_PREPARE_ACTION       I DATA_CHANGES_AFTER_PREPARE    Changes after preparing the action                          .
IF_EX_VLC_PREPARE_ACTION       I DATA_CHANGES_BEFORE_PREPARE   Changes before preparing the action                         .
IF_EX_VLC_PRESELECTION         I GET_ROOT_CLASS                Return the root class for the vehicle model hierarchy       .
IF_EX_VLC_PRESELECTION         I UPDATE_TREE_ICONS             Update icons of preselection tree                           .
IF_EX_VLC_SEARCH_ADAPTION      I CONDITIONS_CHANGE             Direktes-Ändern der SQL-conditionen                         .
IF_EX_VLC_SEARCH_ADAPTION      I GET_CONFIG_TEXT               Configuration Text in search                                .
IF_EX_VLC_SEARCH_ADAPTION      I INPUT_PREPROCESSING           Verarbeitung der Eingangsparameter                          .
IF_EX_VLC_SEARCH_ADAPTION      I LIVECACHE_IBASE_SWITCH        Auswahl der Suchmaschine                                    .
IF_EX_VLC_SEARCH_ADAPTION      I OUTPUT_POSTPROCESSING         Verarbeitung der Ausgangsparameter                          .
IF_EX_VLC_USED_VEHICLES        I MAP_CONFIGURATIONS            Mapping of condigurations                                   .
IF_EX_VLC_USED_VEHICLES        I MOVE_CALCSHEET_AMOUNT_TO_UI   Move amount from the calculation sheet to dynpro structures .
IF_EX_VLC_USED_VEHICLES        I PREPARE_CALCULATION_SHEET     Insert own conditions in the used vehicle calculation sheet .
IF_EX_VLC_USED_VEHICLES        I VALIDATE_MAPPING              Validate requested mapping                                  .
IF_EX_VMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCKS     I LOCK                          Lock                                                        .
IF_EX_VMD_ADDITIONAL_LOCKS     I UNLOCK                        Unlock                                                      .
IF_EX_VOR_WA_FAKTURA           I VOR_WA_DATA_GET               FETCH DATA BEFORE GOODS ISSUE                               .
IF_EX_VSCAN_INSTANCE           I GET_INSTANCE                  Provide an Instance of the External Virus Scanner           .
IF_EX_W3_F4_MODULE             I HANDLE_VALUE_REQUEST          Output value list                                           .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_001            I INTERFACE_PROMOTION_DATA      Make Update Data Available to External Applications         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_001            I SUGGEST_ITEM_DATA             Default Item Data                                           .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_001            I SUGGEST_PLANTGROUP_DATA       Default Plant Group Data                                    .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_001            I SUGGEST_STANDARD_SALES_PRICE  Default Standard Sales Price                                .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I BUILD_ALLOC_TABLE_DEL_PHASE   Construction of Allocation Tables - Delivery Phases         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I DEL_PHASE_ARCHIEVE            Issue Error Message for the Old Archiving Object            .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I MAINTAIN_DEL_PHASE            Interface Transaction WAK5 / ADD-ON                         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I POST_DEL_PHASE                Call Update Posting Add-On                                  .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I PRINT_DEL_PHASE               Print Delivery Phases                                       .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_002            I SENDREPLY_DEL_PHASE           Confirmation of Delivery Phases                             .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I ADD_PG_FROM_DB                Add Plant Group(s) to the Class                             .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I APPLY_VTL_FILTER_TO_PLGRP     Apply Distr. Ch. Filter to Local Site Group                 .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I CHECK_FOR_DOUBLE_PLANTS       Check for Double Plants in a Promotion                      .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I COPY_PLANTS                   Copy Plants from Reference Promotion                        .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I DELETE_PLANTS                 Delete Plant Data for Intra-Promotional Plant Groups        .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I DELETE_PLGRP                  Delete a Promotion-Internal Plant Group                     .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I IMPORT_PLGRP_FROM_BAPI_CH     Check and Process Intra-Promotional Plant Groups Using BAPI .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I IMPORT_PLGRP_FROM_BAPI_CR     Check and Process Intra-Promotional Plant Groups Using BAPI .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I MAINTAIN_PLGRP                Maintain Intra-Promotional Plant Groups                     .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I MODIFY_PG                     Modify Plant Group                                          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I POST_PLANTS                   Preparation for Posting Plants to Intra-Prom. Plant Groups  .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I READ_DESCRIPTION_PLGRP        Determine Language-Dependent Name for Intra-Prom. Plant Grps.
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I READ_PLANTS_INTERNAL_PLGRP    Determine Plants for Intra-Promotional Plant Groups         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I REFRESH_IPGRP                 Initialize Function Group                                   .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_003            I TRY_VTL_FILTER                Test Distribution Chain Filter                              .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I ASSIGN_TO_PROMOTION           Assignment to a Higher-Level Promotion                      .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I BAPI_CHANGE_CHANGE_REF_PROMO  BAPI Change: Check Higher-Level Promotion Data              .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I BAPI_CREATE_CHECK_REF_PROMO   BAPI Create: Check Higher-Level Promotion Data              .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I CHECK_REF_PROMO_VALID         Is the reference promotion still on a higher level?         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I COP_REF_PROMO                 Copy Promotion Number from Reference Promotion              .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I DELETE_REF_PROMO              Delete Assignment to a Reference Promotion                  .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I GET_DATA_PAI                  Retrieve Data in Subscreen Container from Global Data       .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I GET_FCODE_PAI                 Retrieve FCODE from the BADI Class                          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Data in Called Screen to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data in Subscreen Container to Global Attributes   .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I PUT_FCODE_PAI                 Transfer FCODE of Carrying Object to BADI Class             .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I READ_KOPFTEXT                 Read Name of Higher-Level Promotion and Campaign            .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I SET_BEKST2_FLAG               Set Status of New Announcement                              .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I SET_RESET_RWAKA_KFLAGS        Set or Delete the RWAKA Copy Flag                           .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_004            I SHOW_POPUP_BEKST2             View of New Announcement                                    .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I BUILD_CHANGE_POINTERS         Structure of Change Pointers Table                          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I COP_AH_AHS_REBATE             Copy Promotion Discounts When Creating with Template        .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I GET_DATA_PAI                  Retrieve Data in Subscreen Container from Global Data       .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I GET_DATA_PBO                  Retrieve Data in Called Screen from Global Attributes       .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I GET_FCODE_PAI                 Retrieve FCODE from the BADI Class                          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I HIERID_DETERMINE              Determines the Valid Hierarchy ID                           .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I PUT_DATA_PAI                  Transfer Data in Called Screen to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I PUT_DATA_PBO                  Transfer Data in Subscreen Container to Global Attributes   .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I PUT_FCODE_PAI                 Transfer FCODE of Carrying Object to BADI Class             .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I PUT_PROMO_HEADER              Transfer Promotion Header Data to Global Attributes         .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I READ_AH_BEZ                   Read Descriptions for Article Hierarchy and Season          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_005            I SETTLE_XCALP_VB_ERRORS        Error Handling for XCALP_VB Record                          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_007            I ASSIGNMENTTYPE_DETERMINE      Determine Assignment Type (Art.Hier. or Org.Level/Mat.Grp)  .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_007            I POPUP_FOR_PRICE_CHANGE        Popup for Price Changes                                     .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_007            I POPUP_MASS_MAINT_NVKP         Mass Maintenance Standard Sales Price Dialog Box            .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_008            I PLTYP_LEVELS_GET              PPW: Determine All Price Lists for a Price Plan             .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_008            I PLTYP_LEVELS_SHOW             Promotion: Display Several Price Lists                      .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_008            I PLTYP_PRICES_GET              PPW: Determine Prices for Articles of a Price Plan          .
IF_EX_WAKT_BADI_008            I PPW_CUSTOMIZING_READ          PPW: Read the Customizing Settings                          .
IF_EX_WALL_DETERMINE_DC        I BADI_RAT_DETERMINE_DC         Supply Source Determination for Customers                   .
IF_EX_WARRANTY_EXPIRY_ESTIMATE I ESTIMATE_EXPIRY_DATE          Warranty End Date Estimation                                .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_AT_FCODES_I       I ARTH_DATA_DET                 Determine a Node in the Article Hierarchy                   .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_AT_FCODES_I       I MSEL_EINDT                    Delivery Date Multiple Selection                            .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_AT_FCODES_I       I MSEL_MATNR                    Multiple Selection for Material                             .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_AT_FCODES_I       I REC_MATRX_CALL                Call Recipient Matrix                                       .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_STORE_CONSTRA     I AT_FC_CONSTRAINT_DELPHASE     Delivery Phase Determination                                .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_STORE_CONSTRA     I AT_FC_CONSTRAINT_DELPHASETIME Delivery Phase Determination                                .
IF_EX_WAUF_X_STORE_CONSTRA     I AT_FC_CONSTRAINT_STORE        Site Combination                                            .
IF_EX_WB0X_ADD_CUST_DATA_E     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Retrieve Data from New Subscreen in Add-On                  .
IF_EX_WB0X_ADD_CUST_DATA_E     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Display Data in New Subscreen in Add-On                     .
IF_EX_WB0X_CHECK_SCHLDAT_I     I CHECK_CLOSEDAT_DEPSTORE       Check Whether Closing Date of Department Store Is OK        .
IF_EX_WB0X_CHECK_SHOP_E        I CHECK_SHOPDATA                Consistency Check Between Department Store and Shops        .
IF_EX_WB0X_CHECK_SHOP_E        I CHECK_SHOP_NAME               Check Whether Name Was Entered Correctly                    .
IF_EX_WB0X_CHECK_SHOP_E        I CUSTOMER_CHECK                Customer Checks (of T001W, WRS1)                            .
IF_EX_WB0X_CHECK_STTYPE_I      I VALID_STORETYPE               Check T001W-STORETYPE for a Site                            .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_ADDR_DATA_I     I BUILDUP_ADDRESS_DATA_DEPSTORE Copy Address Data to Higher-Level Department Store          .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_ADDR_DATA_I     I GET_DEPSTORE_NAME             Copy Name from Higher-Level Department Store                .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_DATA_I          I FILL_ORGA_DATA                Copy Org. Data of Higher-Level Department Store             .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_DATA_I          I FILL_STRUCT                   Fill New Fields of Structure WR02D                          .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_DATA_I          I FILL_T001W_DEPSTORE           Copy Higher-Level Department Store and Store Type           .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_DATA_I          I FILL_WRS1                     Supply Table WRS1 with Category and Hier_ID                 .
IF_EX_WB0X_GET_DATA_I          I GET_CATEGORY                  Copy Category and Hier_ID of Shop                           .
IF_EX_WB0X_HIER_ID_CHECK_I     I HIER_ID_CHECK                 Check Whether Hierarchie_ID Has Changed                     .
IF_EX_WB0X_SHOW_SHOP_DAT_I     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Retrieve Data from Subscreen 3000                           .
IF_EX_WB0X_SHOW_SHOP_DAT_I     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Display Data in Subscreen 3000                              .
IF_EX_WB2B_CM                  I CHECK                         Execute Check                                               .
IF_EX_WB2B_CM                  I DISPLAY_PROTOCOL              Issue Log                                                   .
IF_EX_WB2B_CM                  I GET_MASTER_DATA               Determine Master Data From FSCM                             .
IF_EX_WB2B_CM                  I UPDATE                        Execute Check                                               .
IF_EX_WB2B_CM                  I UPDATE_CHECK                  Carry Out Check - is Saving Possible                        .
IF_EX_WB2C_CFM                 I CONVERT_UNITS                 Convert Units Traded on the Stock Exchange to Material Units.
IF_EX_WB2C_CFM                 I CONVERT_UNITS_MULTIPLE        Convert Stock Exchange-Traded Units to Material Units (1:n) .
IF_EX_WB2C_CFM                 I MATERIAL_REL_FORHEDGING       Check If Hedging Wanted for This Material                   .
IF_EX_WB2C_CFM                 I MATNR_TO_RANL                 Assign Security ID Number to Material Number                .
IF_EX_WB2C_CFM                 I RANL_TO_MATNR                 Assign Material Number to Security ID Number                .
IF_EX_WB2C_FX                  I CALC_DATE_FOR_TC              Calculate Due Date for Trading Contract Schedule Line       .
IF_EX_WB2C_FX                  I CHANGE_PARA_FOR_CREATE        Change Parameter in BAPI for Generating a FET               .
IF_EX_WB2C_FX                  I SWITCH_OFF_HEDGING            Switch Off Hedging                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ACTION_LEAD_DOC      I CHECK_BEFORE_LEADING          Check Before Calling Leading Transaction                    .
IF_EX_WB2_ACTION_PARAM_MOD     I LAST_COMMIT                   ACTION CLASS: Last Update Process                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ACTION_PARAM_MOD     I MODIFY                        ACTION CLASS PARAMETERS customer modification               .
IF_EX_WB2_ACTION_PROCESS       I CHECK_AFTER_MAINDOC_POST      Check                                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AFTER_COPY             Format Data After Copying                                   .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AFTER_READ             Prepare Data After Reading                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AT_UPDATE              Provide Add-On Data For Update                              .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_BEFORE_SET_COMP_FLAG   Change Add-On Data Before Setting Indicator                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Make Changes Before Update                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_BUSINESS_DATA          Change Business Data                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_DATA                   Change Dates                                                .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS          Swap Description on Title Element                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_ADD_ON_DATA             Check Standard Add-On Data                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Perform Last Checks Before Updating                         .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_COMPLETION              Check If FLI Can Be Set                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_DATA                    Check Data                                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CONFIRM_CANCEL_STEP           Check if Cancellation Process is Possible                   .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I COPY_PREPARE                  Prepare Data Transfer                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATALOSS_CHECK                Check Loss of Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I FIELD_SELECTION               Perform Field Selection                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_EXTENSIONS                Get All Add-On Data for BAPI Methods                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_HOLD_DATA                 Get Held Data                                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_INACTIVE_TAXI_FCODES      Transfer Inactive FCodes for Title Element                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_INIT_DATA                 Initial Data Setting for Incoming Delivery                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_ITEM_DATA                 Transfer Item Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_SCREEN                    Adopt Screen                                                .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I GET_TAXI_SCREEN               Determine Screen for Tab Title                              .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I IS_CHECK_DISABLED             Switch Off "Direct Successor of a TC?" Check                .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ITEM_NUMBER_CHANGE            Change Item Number                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Switch Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I PREP_FOR_HISTORY              Format Data for Change History                              .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I PUSH_COMPLETE_FLAG_BACK       Special Handling when Resaving Completion Flag              .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I REFRESH                       Initialize Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I REFRESH_LIGHT                 Initialize Data without Database                            .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data                                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_DOCUMENT_DATA             Process Document Data                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_EXTENSION                 Transfer Add-On Data for BAPI Methods in Trading Contract   .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_EXTERNAL_NUMBER           Transfer External Number to Item Level                      .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_FCODE                     Return Function Code to Initiator                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_HEADER_DATA               Transfer Header Data                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_HOLD_DATA                 Save Data to be Held                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SYNC_AFTER_READ               Adjust Data After Document Data Is Updated                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SYNC_AT_UPDATE                Postprocess Data at Update                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SYNC_MAIN_HEADER_DATA         Transfer Leading Document Data                              .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON                I DISPLAY                       Display Document                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON                I GET_LEVEL                     Level in Document Flow Tree (Within Enhancement Documents)  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON                I GET_TEXT                      Descriptive Text with Document Number and Document Category .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECTZ1                      Select Data                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECTZ2                      Select Data                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECTZ3                      Select Data                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECT_DOC_NUM_Z1             Select Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECT_DOC_NUM_Z2             Select Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_DATA           I SELECT_DOC_NUM_Z3             Select Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ADDON_FLOW           I READ_FLOW                     Read Document Flow                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Perform Last Checks Before Updating                         .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I DATALOSS_CHECK                Check Loss of Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I GET_INIT_DATA                 Initial Data Setting for Incoming Delivery                  .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I HANDLE_FCODE_END              Perform Final Function Code Processing After PAI            .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I REFRESH                       Initialize Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I SET_HEADER_DATA               Transfer Header Data for Current Document                   .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I SET_ITEM_DATA                 Transfer Item Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I SET_ITEM_SCREEN               Get Additional Screen Charge Back                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_DATA_INT         I SET_SCREEN                    Get Additional Screen Charge Back                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ADD_TO_SELECTION     I ADD                           Add New Selection Ranges                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_AFTER_ACTION         I RESET                         Reset External Data                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AC               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AC               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ1          I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ1          I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ2          I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ2          I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ3          I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_ADDONZ3          I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AGENCY           I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AGENCY           I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AGENCY_LST       I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_AGENCY_LST       I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_DELIVERY         I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_DELIVERY         I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_IV               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_IV               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_MD               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_MD               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_PO               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_PO               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SI               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SI               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SI_LST           I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SI_LST           I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SO               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_SO               I MODIFY                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_TC               I GET_EXT_KEY                   Set Extension Key (for Item Split)                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_TC               I MODIFY                        Change ALV Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_VARIANT          I GET_VARIANT                   Set Variant Key                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_VIEW             I CHANGE_SAVE_FLAG              Save Parameters for ALV Control                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ALV_VIEW             I SWITCH_HEAD_DISPLAY_OFF       Do Not Display Document Headers                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ARCHIVE              I CAN_DOC_BE_ARCHIVED           Archive document?                                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ARCHIVE              I DEL                           Delete Data from Database During Deletion Run               .
IF_EX_WB2_ARCHIVE              I WRITE_CLASS                   Write to Archiving Class                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_ARCHIVE_INT          I WRITE_CLASS                   Write to Archiving Class                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSOCIATION          I CROSS_REF_CHECK               Deactivate Cross-Reference Test                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSOCIATION          I CROSS_REF_CHECK_FOR_LEADER    Deactivate Cross-Reference Test for Individual Item         .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSOCIATION_VIEW     I IS_EDIT_OFF                   Deactivate Input Availability                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSOCIATION_VIEW     I RESORT                        Sort Output Data                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSO_SUBSTITUTE      I ASSOCIATE                     Execute Associations                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSO_SUBSTITUTE      I IS_SUBSTITUTED                Replace Standard Association Handling                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSO_VARIANT         I CHANGE_ASSO_ALV               Variants For Associated Documents                           .
IF_EX_WB2_ASSO_VARIANT         I CHANGE_LEADER_ALV             Variants For Leading Documents                              .
IF_EX_WB2_AUTO_ASSOC           I CHANGE_AUTO_ASSOC             Activate/Deactivate Automatic Association Determination     .
IF_EX_WB2_BDC_MODIFICATION     I MODIFY                        BDCDATA customer modification                               .
IF_EX_WB2_BW_ADD_DATA          I CHANGE_BW_DATA                Enhance BW Data Before Update                               .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_DL              Calculate Date for Delivery                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_IV              Calculate Date for Invoice Verification                     .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_MD              Calculate Date for Material Document                        .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_PO              Calculate Date for Purchase Order                           .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_SI              Calculate Date for Customer Billing Document                .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_SO              Calculate Date for Sales Order                              .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_TC              Calculate Date for Trading Contract                         .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_DATE            I CALC_DATE_FOR_VBD             Calculate Date for Vendor Billing Document                  .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_SCENARIO        I CALCULATE_SCENARIO            Determine Business Scenario                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_DL             Calculate Value for Delivery                                .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_IV             Calculate Value for Invoice Verification                    .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_MD             Calculate Value for Material Document                       .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_PO             Calculate Value for Purchase Order                          .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_SI             Calculate Value for Customer Billing Document               .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_SO             Calculate Value for Sales Order                             .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_TC             Calculate Value for Trading Contract                        .
IF_EX_WB2_CALC_VALUE           I CALC_VALUE_FOR_VBD            Calculate Value for Vendor Billing Document                 .
IF_EX_WB2_CHECK_TC_COMP        I CHECK_COMP_EXPENSE_DOCUMENT   Check Whether Delivery Cost Documents Are Completed         .
IF_EX_WB2_CHECK_TC_COMP        I CHECK_COMP_FI                 Check Accounting Documents for Completion                   .
IF_EX_WB2_CHECK_TC_COMP        I CHECK_COMP_ITEM               Check that Item Is Completed                                .
IF_EX_WB2_CHK_ASSO_PARTNER     I CHECK_QUAN_OF_PARTNERS        Check If the Quantity of Association Partners Is Sufficient .
IF_EX_WB2_CHK_ASSO_PARTNER     I QUANTITY_IS_VALID             Additional Check                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_COMPRESS_GR          I IS_GR_COMPRESS_ON             Compression Activated?                                      .
IF_EX_WB2_CONDITION            I AFTER_CONDITION_COPY          Report Data After Copying                                   .
IF_EX_WB2_CONDITION            I AT_CONDITION_COPY             Set Default Data When Copying                               .
IF_EX_WB2_CONDITION            I AT_CONDITION_CREATE           Set Default Data at Creation                                .
IF_EX_WB2_CONDITION_TRANS      I CONDITION_TRANSFER            Transfer Conditions                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_DEACTIVATE_LINKS     I CHECK_DEACTIVATE              Check Follow-On Document Deactivation                       .
IF_EX_WB2_DELIVERY_INPUT       I DELIVERY_INPUT                Input Data Modification for Delivery                        .
IF_EX_WB2_DEQUEUE_SERVICE      I CHECK_SO_ENQUEUE              ENQUEUE Check at Sales Order Level                          .
IF_EX_WB2_DEQUEUE_SERVICE      I CHECK_TC_ENQUEUE              ENQUEUE Check at Trading Contract Level                     .
IF_EX_WB2_DISPLAY_DOC          I DISPLAY                       Display Document                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_DISPLAY_DOC          I IS_EXTERNAL_DISPLAY_ACTIVE    Is external display function active?                        .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_COPY        I CHANGE_COPY_LAYOUT            Change Layout of Item Overview                              .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_COPY        I CHANGE_SPLITT_LAYOUT          Change Layout of Split Display                              .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_COPY        I FILTER_ITEMS                  Filter Items                                                .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_COPY        I MATERIAL_CHECK                Check Material                                              .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_COPY        I PREPARE_SPLITT_ITEMS          Prepare Split Items                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I AT_REFRESH                    Is Called at Point of Refresh                               .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I CHANGE_HEADER_DATA            Change Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA              Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Switch Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I CHECK_RELEASE                 Check as to Whether New Release Is Necessary                .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_INT         I RUN_ON_ITEM_DELETION          Method on Deletion of Items                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_KEYS        I GET_LAST_ACTION_CLASS_DATA    Read Document Keys                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_KEYS        I MERGE_ACTION_CLASS_DATA       Merge Document Keys                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_DOCUMENT_KEYS        I UPDATE_ACTION_CLASS_DATA      Update Document Keys                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_ASSO         I ENHANCE_ALV                   Enhance Display Fields                                      .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_ASSO         I ENHANCE_REPORT_ALV            Enhance Display Fields for TC                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_EXPENSE      I CHANGE_AFTER_CHANGE_VBD       Change Expenses Document after Changing                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_EXPENSE      I CHANGE_AFTER_CREATE_VBD       Change Expenses Document after Creation                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_HISTORY      I ENHANCE                       Enhance Entry                                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_KOMASSO      I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I BREAK_DOWN_CALCULATION        Extensions of Routines of the Breakdown of Conditions       .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I CHANGE_RETAIL_PRICING         Transfer Price Determination Data to the Pricing Document   .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I ENHANCE                       Enhance Retail Pricing Data                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I EXTEND_HEADER_DATA            Enhance Header Data for Pricing                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I EXTEND_ITEM_DATA              Enhance Item Data for Pricing                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRICING      I GET_DATA_AFTER_CHANGE         Pricing Data After Provision                                .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I CHANGE_RETAIL_PRICING         Transfer Price Determination Data to the Pricing Document   .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I ENHANCE                       Enhance Retail Pricing Data                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I EXTEND_HEADER_DATA            Enhance Header Data for Pricing                             .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I EXTEND_ITEM_DATA              Enhance Item Data for Pricing                               .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I FILL_CONDITIONS               Expand Main Conditions                                      .
IF_EX_WB2_ENHANCE_PRIC_INT     I GET_DATA_AFTER_CHANGE         Pricing Data After Provision                                .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I ALLOCATE_TEXT                 Allocate Text and/or Icons to Pushbuttons                   .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I AT_READ                       Actions on Reading Trading Contracts                        .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I CUA_EXCLUDE                   Change Menu Status                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I FCODE_EXECUTE                 Execute Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I MODIFY_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES       Change Field Attributes                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_ENH_SCREEN_INT       I SET_POSITION_FCODE            Flag Function Code as Item-Related                          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I ACTIVATE_AUTOMATIC_COPY       Activate Automatic Copying from Preceding Document          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I ACTIVATE_CUSTOMER_SCREEN      Activate Customer Add-On Screen                             .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AKA_KURO_CANCEL               Extension for Creating New Billing Docs Instead Of Cancellat.
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AKA_KURO_CANCEL_SINGLE        Extension for Creating New Billing Docs Instead Of Cancellat.
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_BASEVALUE_PLANNED_CON      Exchange Base Value For Planned Conditions                  .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_BEFORE_FI_RELEASED         Influence the Data before Release for FI                    .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_BEFORE_FI_RELEASED_RECOVERYInfluence Data Before Releasing to FI for Recovery          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_BUILD_KOMV_PLANNED         Change the Created KOMV for the Planned Delivery Costs      .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_COLUMNSELECTION            Switch On Expense Partner Fields                            .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPCLASSGROUP_F4           Influence on F4 Help for Expense Class Group                .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPCLASS_F4                Influence on F4 Help for Expense Class                      .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPENSE_BREAKDOWN          Change Expenses After Distribution to the Item              .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPENSE_ENTRY              Automatic Inclusion of Data When Calling Expenses           .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPENSE_PLANNED_GET        Changes in Module of Planned Conditions                     .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPENSE_SAVE               Change Expense Data Before Saving                           .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_EXPENSE_SAVE2              Additional Exit                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_FINAL_CHECK                Suppress Final Check                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_POSTTYPE_F4                Influence on F4 Help for Expense Class Group                .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_READ_ASSO_DATA             Read Association Data for the Delivery Costs                .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_WORKAREA_CREATE            Changes to Work Area Before Creation                        .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AT_WORKAREA_DELETE            Data For Deleted Data                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I AUTOMATIC_COPY_PARAMETERS     Change Parameters for Automatic Copying                     .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CHECK_BEFORE_CANCEL           Customer-Specific Checks Before Cancellation                .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CHECK_BEFORE_CREATE_CONDITION Checks Before Master Conditions Are Created                 .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CHECK_BEFORE_CREATE_CONDITION2Checks Before Master Conditions Are Created                 .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CHECK_BEFORE_DELETION         Additional Checks Before Expense Document Is Deleted        .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CHECK_BEFORE_FCODE_ONLINE     Additional Checks When Triggering a Transaction             .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CONDITION_TEXT_COPY           Extension for Copying Condition Text to VBD Header          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CUSTOMER_SCREEN_PAI           Transport Data from Customer Screen                         .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I CUSTOMER_SCREEN_PBO           Transport Data to Customer Screen                           .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I FIELDSELECTION_WORKAREA       Field Selection in the Work Area                            .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I GET_DEFAULTS_FOR_CONDITION    Set Defaults for Master Conditions                          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I GET_EXPENSE_DATA              Transfer all Existing Expense Data                          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I SET_INVOICE_DATE_FOR_CANCEL   Determine Billing Date in Case of Cancellation              .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE      I WORKAREA_AUTOMATIC_CREATION   Changes in Work Area During Automatic Creation              .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE2     I AT_EXPENSE_FILTER             Filter Expenses in a Recovery Case                          .
IF_EX_WB2_EXPENSE_ENHANCE2     I AT_EXPENSE_SAVE               Data Processing at Point of Update                          .
IF_EX_WB2_FILTER_ROOT_DOCS     I FILTER                        Filter Out Unnecessary Root Documents                       .
IF_EX_WB2_FILTER_SOURCE        I FILTER                        Filter Source Documents                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_FILTER_TARGET        I FILTER                        Filter Target Documents                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_FILTER_TARG_ROOT     I FILTER                        Filter Out Root Documents from Target Document Selection    .
IF_EX_WB2_FINAL_CHECK_ASSO     I ADJUSTM_ASSO_BY_OPEN_QUAN     Adjust Associations Due To an Open Quantity                 .
IF_EX_WB2_FINAL_CHECK_ASSO     I ADJUSTM_ASSO_BY_OVER_ASSO     Adjust Associations Due To an Ass. Qty That is Too Large    .
IF_EX_WB2_FINAL_CHECK_ASSO     I FINAL_CHECK_ASSO              Final Check of an Item                                      .
IF_EX_WB2_FLOW_TREE            I CHANGE_LEVEL                  Change Level                                                .
IF_EX_WB2_GI_CANC_INPUT        I CHANGE_BEFORE_CANCEL          Input data change before cancellation                       .
IF_EX_WB2_GI_CANC_OUTPUT       I CHECK_AFTER_CANCEL            Output data check after cancellation                        .
IF_EX_WB2_GR_CANC_INPUT        I CHANGE_BEFORE_CANCEL          Input data change before cancellation                       .
IF_EX_WB2_GR_CANC_OUTPUT       I CHECK_AFTER_CANCEL            Output data check after cancellation                        .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_CALL             I CHECK                         Check GTS Data                                              .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_CALL             I RELEASE_CHECK                 Check GTS Data Before Release                               .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_CALL             I SIMULTATION                   Simulate GTS Data Update                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_CALL             I UPDATE                        Update GTS Data                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_ENHANCE          I CHECK_DOCUMENT                Check Update to Document Level                              .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_ENHANCE          I CHECK_ITEM                    Check Update to Item Level                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_GTS_ENHANCE          I MODIFY                        Adjust Update Data                                          .
IF_EX_WB2_HIDE_ASSO_BUTTON     I GET_BLIND_OUT                 Hide Association Key                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_IDOC_OUTPUT_CHG      I MODIFY_CONTROL_DATA           Modify IDOC Control Data (EDI_DC)                           .
IF_EX_WB2_IDOC_OUTPUT_CHG      I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify IDOC Data                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_IDOC_OUTPUT_DATA     I MODIFY_CONTROL_DATA           Modify IDOC Control Data (EDI_DC)                           .
IF_EX_WB2_IDOC_OUTPUT_DATA     I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify IDOC Data                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_INCOM_LIV_INPUT      I LIV_INPUT                     INPUT DATA MODIFICATION FOR LIV                             .
IF_EX_WB2_INCOM_LIV_OUTPUT     I LIV_OUTPUT                    OUTPUT DATA MODIFICATION FOR LIV                            .
IF_EX_WB2_KOMASSO_VISU_ACT     I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_EX_WB2_LIV_CANC_INPUT       I LIV_INPUT                     INPUT DATA MODIFICATION FOR LIV Cancellation                .
IF_EX_WB2_LIV_CANC_OUTPUT      I LIV_OUTPUT                    OUTPUT DATA MODIFICATION FOR LIV Cancellation               .
IF_EX_WB2_MASS_CHANGE_TC       I CHANGE_FIELDLIST              Change Field List                                           .
IF_EX_WB2_MASS_CHANGE_TC       I CHANGE_FOR_ADD_ON_TABLE       Change Your Own Add-On Tables                               .
IF_EX_WB2_MASS_CHANGE_TC       I CHECK_FIELD                   Check Fields                                                .
IF_EX_WB2_MAT_POS_MGMT         I ADDITIONAL_DATA               Data Enhancement                                            .
IF_EX_WB2_MAT_POS_MGMT         I MAT_POS_MGMT_ENHANCE          Obsolete Is no Longer Used                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_MEPO_INPUT           I MEPO_INPUT_ONLINE             INPUT DATA MODIFICATION FOR MEPO online                     .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_DB_READ     Change Data After Completing Data Determination             .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_TC_READ     Change Trading Contract Data                                .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_DB_PARAMETERS          Change Selection Parameter for Database Selection           .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_FINALLY                Make Final Changes to Data                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_OBJKEY                 Change Object Key for Message Control Records               .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I CHANGE_PRINT_PARAMETERS       Change Param. for Selecting Table to Be Filled for Printing .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST                 I GET_DATA_AFTER_PRINT          Makes Data Available After Printing                         .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_DB_READ     Change Data After Completing Data Determination             .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_TC_READ     Change Trading Contract Data                                .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_DB_PARAMETERS          Change Selection Parameter for Database Selection           .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_FINALLY                Make Final Changes to Data                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_OBJKEY                 Change Object Key for Message Control Records               .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I CHANGE_PRINT_PARAMETERS       Change Param. for Selecting Table to Be Filled for Printing .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_CUSTOMER        I GET_DATA_AFTER_PRINT          Makes Data Available After Printing                         .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_DB_READ     Change Data After Completing Data Determination             .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_DATA_AFTER_TC_READ     Change Trading Contract Data                                .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_DB_PARAMETERS          Change Selection Parameter for Database Selection           .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_FINALLY                Make Final Changes to Data                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_OBJKEY                 Change Object Key for Message Control Records               .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I CHANGE_PRINT_PARAMETERS       Change Param. for Selecting Table to Be Filled for Printing .
IF_EX_WB2_NAST_VENDOR          I GET_DATA_AFTER_PRINT          Makes Data Available After Printing                         .
IF_EX_WB2_NUMBER_CHANGE        I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Change Number Assignment                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_POST_DATA_INT        I DATA_POST                     Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_WB2_PRODUCT_SUB          I PRODUCT_SUBSTITUTION          Replacement Material Determination                          .
IF_EX_WB2_QUANT_VARIANCE       I CALCULATE_PRECEED_VOL         Calculation of Preceding Document Volume                    .
IF_EX_WB2_QUANT_VARIANCE       I HANDLE_LIPS_VOLUME            Handling Delivery Item Volume                               .
IF_EX_WB2_REASSO_POPUP         I IS_DISPLAYED                  Should the dialog box be displayed?                         .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_ACCOUNTING    Purchase Order: Change Account Assignment                   .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_HEADER        Purchase Order: Change Header                               .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_ITEM          Purchase Order: Change Items                                .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_SCHEDULE      Purchase Order: Change Schedule Lines                       .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_SALES_HEADER           Sales Order: Change Header                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_SALES_ITEM             Sales Order: Change Item                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_SALES_PARTNER          Sales Order: Change Partner                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CHANGE_SALES_SCHEDULE         Sales Order: Change Schedule Lines                          .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CREATE_ADDITIONALS            Subsequent Action After Release                             .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CREATE_PURCHASE_HEADER_TEXT   Fill Header Texts                                           .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I CREATE_PURCHASE_ITEM_TEXT     Fill Item Texts                                             .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I INIT                          Initialization Type                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_RELEASE_CHANGES      I SHOW_PROTOCOL                 Display Log                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_ACCOUNTING    Purchase Order: Change Account Assignment                   .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_HEADER        Purchase Order: Change Header                               .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_ITEM          Purchase Order: Change Items                                .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_PURCHASE_SCHEDULE      Purchase Order: Change Schedule Lines                       .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_SALES_HEADER           Sales Order: Change Header                                  .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_SALES_ITEM             Sales Order: Change Item                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_SALES_PARTNER          Sales Order: Change Partner                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CHANGE_SALES_SCHEDULE         Sales Order: Change Schedule Lines                          .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I CREATE_ADDITIONALS            Create Additional Documents                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I INIT                          Initialization Type                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I PUBLISH_PO_AFTER_POSTING      Publish Purchasing Document Data After Saving               .
IF_EX_WB2_REL_CHANGES_INT      I PUBLISH_SO_AFTER_POSTING      Publish Sales Document Data After Saving                    .
IF_EX_WB2_SALES_INV_INPUT      I INVOICE_INPUT                 input data modification for sales invoice                   .
IF_EX_WB2_SALES_INV_OUTPUT     I INVOICE_OUTPUT                TO GET OUTPUT DATA FROM INVOICE                             .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS          Swap Description on Title Element                           .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I GET_DATA_HEADER               Get Header Data from Trading Contract                       .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I GET_INACTIVE_TAXI_FCODES      Transfer Inactive FCodes for Title Element                  .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I GET_SCREEN                    Program/Screen of Add-On                                    .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I SET_BUSINESS_DATA_DEFAULT     Set Default Value for Business Data                         .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I SET_DATA_HEADER               Save Header Data to Trading Contract Again                  .
IF_EX_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANC_TC     I SWITCH_HEADER_EXIT_ON         Activate Header Exit                                        .
IF_EX_WB2_SHOW_DOC_IN_FLOW     I CHANGE                        Change Text                                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_SHOW_DOC_IN_FLOW     I CHANGE_ASSO_DOCS              Change Associated Documents                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_SHOW_DOC_IN_FLOW     I DELETED                       Document Deleted?                                           .
IF_EX_WB2_SHOW_DOC_IN_FLOW     I VISIBLE                       Should the Document Be Displayed?                           .
IF_EX_WB2_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_SIGNS_MCWBHI           Change Sign in MCWBHI                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_STEP_CHANGED         I RESET                         Reset External Data                                         .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_CHANGE_INT        I AT_READ                       Execute Tasks When Reading the Trading Contract             .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_CHANGE_INT        I ITEM_COPY                     Copy Item                                                   .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_INCMP_LOG_INT     I AT_DOUBLE_CLICK_INCOMP_LOG    Transfer FCODE on Double Click Extension Fields             .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_INCMP_LOG_INT     I CHANGE_INCOMP_LOG             Extension of Incompleteness Log                             .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_INCOMP_LOG        I AT_DOUBLE_CLICK_INCOMP_LOG    Transfer FCODE on Double Click Extension Fields             .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_INCOMP_LOG        I CHANGE_INCOMP_LOG             Extension of Incompleteness Log                             .
IF_EX_WB2_TC_INCOMP_LOG        I GT_TAB_FCODE                  Transfer FCODE in GT Screen                                 .
IF_EX_WB2_TEW_FCODES           I GET_EXCLUDE_LIST              Deactivate Function Codes                                   .
IF_EX_WB2_TEW_FCODES           I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_WB2_VC_CONFIGURATION     I CONF_CHECK_BEFORE_POST        Save Congiguration Before Saving                            .
IF_EX_WB2_VC_REF_CHAR          I RDG_REF_CHAR_CHANGE           Supply Read Object Characteristics                          .
IF_EX_WB2_VC_REF_CHAR          I UPD_REF_CHAR_CHANGE           Transfer Write Object Characteristics                       .
IF_EX_WB2_VC_REF_CHAR          I VCSD_UPDATE_CONVERT           Convert VCSD_UPDATE to Internal Format                      .
IF_EX_WB30_SELCATWERKS_I       I SELECT_SITES_BY_CATEGORY      Build Worklist for Plants by Category                       .
IF_EX_WBS_ELEMENT_DELETE       I AT_DELETION                   Set Deletion Indicator or Delete WBS Element                .
IF_EX_WBS_FIELDS_FOR_ASSET     I ANL_SWITCH_PSPNR              Replace Temporary with Final WBS Element Numbers            .
IF_EX_WBS_FIELDS_FOR_ASSET     I SET_ANLA_ANLZ                 Transfer Other Fields to Structures ANLA and ANLZ           .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I AIA_TRANSFER                  Appropriation Request Planning Transfer                     .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I CHANGE_FLAG                   Was the costing changed?                                    .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I CHECKEX                       Execution allowed?                                          .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I CLEAR_DELKZ                   ON_COST_ESTIMATE_TMP_SAVE                                   .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I COPY_OBJECT                   WBS Element Copied                                          .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I COPY_VERSN                    Copy Version                                                .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I DELETE                        WBS Element/Project Deleted                                 .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I ECP_EXISTS                    ECP Exists - Complete Check                                 .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I ECP_TMP                       ECP Exists - Only MT_WBS_HIERARCHY                          .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I MAINTAIN                      Call Up Costing                                             .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I RETURN_DATA                   Data for Planning Board                                     .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I ROLLBACK                      Execute Rollback                                            .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I SET_DELKZ                     ON_COST_ESTIMATE_DELETE                                     .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I SIM2OP                        Simulation -" Operative                                     .
IF_EX_WBS_MULTIPLE_ECP         I SWITCH                        Number Switch                                               .
IF_EX_WBS_SETTLEMENT_RULE      I ADD_ADDITIONAL_PARTNERS       Take Additional Partner Roles Into Account                  .
IF_EX_WBS_SETTLEMENT_RULE      I DETERMINE_STRATEGY            Derive Strategy to Determine Settlement Rules               .
IF_EX_WBS_SETTLEMENT_RULE      I FILTER_SD_ORDERS              Constraint on Sales Documents/Sales Document Items          .
IF_EX_WBS_USER_FIELDS_F4       I AT_F4                         F4 help for user field                                      .
IF_EX_WB_MODASS                I SUPPRESS                      Suppress Modification Assistant for an Object               .
IF_EX_WB_NAVIGATION_STACK      I GET_VISUALIZATION_INFO        Get Visualization Information for a Stack Entry             .
IF_EX_WB_OBJ_CTMENU            I UPDATE_CONTEXT_MENU           Update Context Menu                                         .
IF_EX_WB_PACKAGE_DEFAULTS      I AFTER_PACKAGE_CREATION        Actions After Creating Package                              .
IF_EX_WB_PACKAGE_DEFAULTS      I AFTER_PACKAGE_REASSIGNMENT    Actions After Reassigning Package                           .
IF_EX_WB_PACKAGE_DEFAULTS      I GET_CHECK_DEFAULTS            Get Default for Package Check                               .
IF_EX_WB_PACKAGE_DEFAULTS      I GET_TRANSPORT_DEFAULTS        Get Default for Software Component and Transport Layer      .
IF_EX_WB_PROCESS_FCODE         I DISPATCH                      Process Function Code                                       .
IF_EX_WB_SLS_MAIL_INFO         I PACKAGE_CREATION_INFO         Pass On Data of New Package                                 .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFG_USED_LIST                Where-Used List: Approvals                                  .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFS_WCM_UPDATE               Status "Work Clearance Management"                          .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFS_WORK_COMPLETED           Status "Work Completed"                                     .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFS_WORK_IN_EXECUTION        Status "Released for Execution"                             .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_EQUIPMENT_USED_LIST      Where-Used List: Equipment                                  .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_FUNC_LOCATION_USED_LIST  Where-Used List: Functional Location                        .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_ORDER_INIT               Initialize                                                  .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_ORDER_LOG_ANALYZE        Evaluation of Logs for Saving Assigned WCM Objects          .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_ORDER_PUSHBUTTONS        Toolbar                                                     .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_ORDER_UPDATE             Save                                                        .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_ORDER_USED_LIST          Where-Used List: Order                                      .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFW_WORK_CENTER_USED_LIST    Where-Used List: Work Center                                .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFX_CANCEL                   Assignments: Reject                                         .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCFX_ORDER_DIALOG             Assignments: Dialog Processing                              .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCGE_ORDER_DIALOG             Valuation: Dialog Processing                                .
IF_EX_WCM_DECOUPLING           I WCGP_ORDER_DIALOG             Approval Groups: Dialog Processing                          .
IF_EX_WDFR_MOD                 I DEF_BSART                     Determine Document Type                                     .
IF_EX_WDFR_MODIFY              I FDIS_SORT_DEF                 Define Columns from TX_FDIS for Sorting                     .
IF_EX_WDFR_SCREEN              I ABNE_SCREEN_ATTRIBUT          Adjust Screen Attributes for Display of ABN                 .
IF_EX_WDFR_SCREEN              I FDIS_SCREEN_ATTRIBUT          Adjust Screen Attributes for Display of FDIS                .
IF_EX_WFD_HCM_INBOUND          I FIELD_UPDATE                  Inbound field update and changing                           .
IF_EX_WFD_HCM_WFD_EM           I SAVE                          Save Start date, Hire date and SSN                          .
IF_EX_WFRM_CRE_DEL_PO_STOD     I CRE_DEL_PO_STOD               Fill Interface for Delivery Generation for Warehouse Orders .
IF_EX_WFRM_CRE_DEL_SO_STOD     I CRE_DEL_SO_STOD               Fill Interface for Delivery Generation for Sales Orders     .
IF_EX_WFRM_CRE_FOLLON_DOC      I DET_TP_CRE_FOLLOWON_DOC       Time Determination for Creating Follow-On Documents         .
IF_EX_WFRM_DET_ORDER_TYPE      I DETERMINE_ORDER_TYPE          Change Defaulted Document Type for Collective Purchase Order.
IF_EX_WFRM_GET_SLS_RELEVANZ    I GET_SLS_RELEVANZ              Determination of SLS Relevance for a Collective PO Item     .
IF_EX_WFRM_PO_READ_STOD        I DET_PO_STOD                   Determine Warehouse Stocks for Merch. Dist. with Stock Red. .
IF_EX_WFRM_SO_READ_STOD        I DET_SO_STOD                   Determine Sales Order for Merch. Distribution with Stock Red.
IF_EX_WF_BWP_DYNAMIC_COLUMNS   I SET_DYNAMIC_COLUMNS           Set Dynamic Columns                                         .
IF_EX_WF_BWP_OBJECT_ATTRIBUTES I SET_DEFAULT_ATTRIBUTES        Set Default Attributes of Objects                           .
IF_EX_WF_BWP_SELECT_FILTER     I APPLY_FILTER                  Filter                                                      .
IF_EX_WF_CONT_MODIFY_PPF       I MODIFY_CONTAINER              Enhance Workflow Start Container                            .
IF_EX_WF_RSWUWFML2             I GET_AGENTS                    Determine Table of Agents for Work Item                     .
IF_EX_WF_RSWUWFML2             I GET_EMAIL                     Determine E-Mail Address for UNAME or WI_ID                 .
IF_EX_WF_RSWUWFML2             I PREPARE                       Preparatory Phase                                           .
IF_EX_WF_SUBSTITUTE            I DELETE_SUBSTITUTE             Delete substitute                                           .
IF_EX_WF_SUBSTITUTE            I MAINTAIN_SUBSTITUTE           Maintain substitute                                         .
IF_EX_WF_SUBSTITUTE            I RESTRICT_PROFILES             Restrict substitute profile                                 .
IF_EX_WGT_SAPI_OUTPUT          I AFTER_PROCESS                 Data oOutput at the Last Part After Method 'OUTPUT' Called  .
IF_EX_WGT_SAPI_OUTPUT          I OUTPUT                        Data Output at the Last Part Before Commit to Database      .
IF_EX_WIND_ADDITIONAL_DATA     I MAINTAIN_ADDITIONAL_DATA      Prepare Condition Types for Price Determination             .
IF_EX_WIND_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_ALLOWED_CHECK          Check Changeability of Documents                            .
IF_EX_WIND_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_PREPARE                Perform Document Index Changes                              .
IF_EX_WIND_ENHANCEMENT         I CUSTOMIZING_CHECK             Check Customizing                                           .
IF_EX_WIND_UPDATE              I WIND_MODIFY                   Modify WIND Entry                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I CHANGE_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENT     Change Account Determination Data After Acct Determination  .
IF_EX_WLF_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I CHANGE_BEFORE_DETERMINATION   Change Account Determination Parameters for MM Acct Detrmntn.
IF_EX_WLF_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I CHANGE_BEFORE_DETERMINATION_SDChange Account Determination Parameters for SD Acct Detrmntn.
IF_EX_WLF_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I CHANGE_DETERMINATION_TYPE     Change Account Determination Category                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ACCOUNT_DETERMIN     I DISPLAY_ACCOUNTING_ANALYSIS   Adjust Account Assignment Analysis Display                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_ACCRUAL_LINE           AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line Accruals              .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_AFTER_SUMMARIZATION    AC Interface: Adjust Data After Aggregation                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_BEFORE_SUMMARIZATION   AC Interface: Adjust Data Before Aggregation                .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_CANCEL_TYPE            Change Cancellation Method                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE          AC Interface: Change Customer Line                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE_ADV_PAYM AC Interface: Change Debtor Advance Pay Posting Line        .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE_COND     AC Interface: Change Customer Condition Line                .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_HEADER_LINE            AC Interface: Change Header Data                            .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_ITEM_LINE              AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_ITEM_LINE_REMU_LIST    AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line Remuneration List     .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_MATERIAL_LINE          AC Interface: Change Material Line                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_POSTING_KEY            Change Posting Key                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_TAX_LINE               AC Interface: Change Tax Line                               .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE            AC Interface: Change Vendor Line                            .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE_ADV_PAYM   AC Interface: Change Creditor Advance Pay Posting Line      .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE_COND       AC Interface: Change Vendor Condition Line                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT      I SET_WRART_CUSTOMERSETTLEMENT  Set Regulation Type for Posting Customer Settlement         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ADJUST_DOCUMENT_STATUS        Change document status on posting list creation             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ADOPT_PRICING_COMPLETE_DATA   Transfer All Data from Pricing Together                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ADOPT_PRICING_DATA            Copy Data from Pricing                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I AT_COPA_GET_PAOBJNR           Set Other Data for Profitability Segment Determination      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CANCEL_CHECK                  Check if cancellation is possible                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CANCEL_CONSISTENCY_CHECK      Consistency Check for Cancellation                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AFTER_PREPARATION      Prepare Data After Read Preparation                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AFTER_READ             Prepare Data after Upload                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AFTER_READ_PREFETCH    Prefetch for CHANGE_AFTER_READ                              .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_AT_UPDATE              Prepare Data for Saving                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Adjust Data Before Saving                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_FIELD_STATUS           Enhancement: Field Selection Settlement Request             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_FIELD_STATUS_TC        Method for Adjusting Table Controls                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_HEADER_DATA            Change Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA              Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA_BEFOR_PRICINGItemData Reg. Docs Before Pricing/Enhancemnt Customer Fields.
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_PRICING_HEADER         Extend Communication Structure KOMK                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_PRICING_ITEM           Extend Communication Structure KOMP                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_PRICING_TYPE_DOC_CHANGEPricing Type for New Pricing After Document Change          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHANGE_PROFIT_SIM_PARAMETERS  Change Parameters For Profit Simulation                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Last Checks for Saving                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Check Header Data                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_HEADER_DATA_LIST_INPUT  Check Header Data for List Creation                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_HEADER_FOR_NEW_PRICING  Check New Pricing for Document Header                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Check Item Data                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CHECK_LFART_FOR_WRART         Billing Type Allowed for Payment Type                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CLEAN_UP                      Take data from processing                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CLOSE_CHECK                   Check Completion Possible                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I CUA_EXCLUDE                   FCODES Exclusion                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATALOSS_CHECK                Check Loss of Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATA_ADOPTION_INV_COLLECTION  Data Transfer for Individual Doc./Collective Doc. Creation  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATA_ADOPTION_PAYMENT_LIST    Data Transfer Posting Lists/Customer Settlement Creation    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATA_ADOPTION_PAYM_LIST_ITEM  Data Transfer of Posting List Item                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATA_ADOPTION_REMU_LIST       Data Transfer of Remuneration List Creation                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DATA_ADOPTION_REMU_LIST_ITEM  Data Transfer for Remuneration List Item                    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I DEQUEUE_ALL                   Unlock All Documents                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ENHANCE_SITE_DATA             Define and Transfer Plant Reference                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I ENQUEUE_ALL                   Lock all Documents                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I FI_DOCUMENT_CHANGE            Change FI Documents/Original Documents for Remuneration List.
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I FI_DOCUMENT_CHANGE_PARAMETERS Set Parameters of FI Documents Change Source Docs of RenLst .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I FI_DOCUMENT_CREATE_CHECK      Check Generation of FI Document                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I INVOICE_COLL_CREATE_CHECK     Check if Collective Document Can Be Generated               .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I INVOICE_LIST_CREATE_CHECK     Check Remuneration List Generation                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I IS_TAXCODE_ALLOWED            Checks Whether Tax Code Is Allowed                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Switch Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I PAYMENT_LIST_CREATE_CHECK     Check Posting List Generation                               .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I PRICING_REFRESH               Reset Pricing Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I PROFIT_SIMULATION             Profit Simulation Data                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I REFRESH                       Reset Data                                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I REOPEN_CHECK                  Check if Completed Document Can be Reopened                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SAVE_CHECK                    Check Save                                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_FI_DOCUMENT_SPLITT        Set FI Document Split Indicator                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Set Reference Fields                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SORT_DOCUMENTS_REPORT_PROCESS Sort Documents for Report Processing                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I SWU_OBJECT_PUBLISH            Publish Business Object                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA      I VENDOR_CUSTOMER_CHECK         Enhancement: Allowed Customer/Vendor Combinations           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I ADJUST_DOCUMENT_STATUS        Change document status on posting list creation             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I ADOPT_PRICING_COMPLETE_DATA   Copy Data from Pricing (Based on PRICING_COMPLETE)          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I ADOPT_PRICING_DATA            Copy Data from Pricing                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I ADOPT_PRICING_VALUES          Set Parameter 'Adjust Pricing'                              .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I ASSIGN_NEW_LIST_ITEM_NUMBER   Sort Items in List Document                                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I AT_COPA_GET_PAOBJNR           Set Other Data for Profitability Segment Determination      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CALCULATE_TAX_AMOUNT          Calculate Tax Amount                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CANCEL_CHECK                  Check if cancellation is possible                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CANCEL_CONSISTENCY_CHECK      Consistency Check for Cancellation                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_AFTER_PREPARATION      Prepare Data After Read Preparation                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_AFTER_READ             Prepare Data After Reading                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_AFTER_READ_PREFETCH    Prefetch for CHANGE_AFTER_READ                              .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_AT_UPDATE              Prepare Data for Saving                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_BEFORE_CREATE_VIA_BAPI Enhance Transfer Data Before Creation using BAPI            .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Adjust Data Before Saving                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_COPY_CONTROL           Change Copy Control Parameters After Reading                .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_FIELD_STATUS           Enhancement: Field Selection Settlement Request             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_FIELD_STATUS_TC        Method for Adjusting Table Controls                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_HEADER_DATA            Change Header Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA              Change Item Data                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA_BEFOR_PRICINGItemData Reg. Docs Before Pricing/Enhancemnt Customer Fields.
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_PRICING_HEADER         Extend Communication Structure KOMK                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_PRICING_ITEM           Extend Communication Structure KOMP                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_PRICING_TYPE_DOC_CHANGEPricing Type for New Pricing After Document Change          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_PRICING_TYPE_FI        Change Valuation Process When Releasing to FI               .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHANGE_PROFIT_SIM_PARAMETERS  Change Parameters For Profit Simulation                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Last Checks for Saving                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_CASH_MNGT_RELEVANT      Check if operation is relevant for Cash Management          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Check Header Data                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_HEADER_DATA_LIST_INPUT  Check Header Data for List Creation                         .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_HEADER_FOR_NEW_PRICING  Check New Pricing for Document Header                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Check Item Data                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_LFART_FOR_WRART         Billing Type Allowed for Payment Type                       .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CHECK_PAYM_RECEIVER           Check Payment Reciever / Payer Eligible                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CLEAN_UP                      Take data from processing                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I CLOSE_CHECK                   Check Completion Possible                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATALOSS_CHECK                Check Loss of Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATA_ADOPTION_INV_COLLECTION  Data Transfer for Single Document/Collective Doc. Creation  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATA_ADOPTION_PAYMENT_LIST    Data Transfer Posting Lists/Customer Settlement Creation    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATA_ADOPTION_PAYM_LIST_ITEM  Data Transfer of Posting List Item                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATA_ADOPTION_REMU_LIST       Data Transfer of Remuneration List Creation                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DATA_ADOPTION_REMU_LIST_ITEM  Data Transfer for Remuneration List Item                    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DETERMINE_RL_DATE_CUST_ACTIVE Check Determination of Remuneration List Date for Customer  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I DETERMINE_RL_DATE_VEND_ACTIVE Check Determination of Remuneration List Date for Vendor    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I EXTERIOR_PAYMENT              Determine Data for Foreign Payment                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I FI_DOCUMENT_CHANGE            Change FI Documents/Original Documents for Remuneration List.
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I FI_DOCUMENT_CHANGE_PARAMETERS Set Parameters of FI Documents Change Source Docs of RenLst .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I FI_DOCUMENT_CREATE_CHECK      Check Generation of FI Document                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I INVOICE_COLL_CREATE_CHECK     Check if Collective Document Can Be Generated               .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I INVOICE_LIST_CREATE_CHECK     Check Remuneration List Generation                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I IS_TAXCODE_ALLOWED            Checks Whether Tax Code Is Allowed                          .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Switch Document Numbers                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I PAYMENT_LIST_CREATE_CHECK     Check Posting List Generation                               .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I PROFIT_SIMULATION             Profit Simulation Data                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I REFRESH                       Reset Data                                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I REOPEN_CHECK                  Check if Completed Document Can be Reopened                 .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SALES_AREA_DETERMINE          Determine Sales Area                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SAVE_CHECK                    Check Save                                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_FI_DOCUMENT_SPLITT        Set FI Document Split Indicator                             .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_HISTORY_WRITE_STATUS      Change Status of Update of Change Document                  .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_ITEM_MAX                  Maximum number of items in a list                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_ITEM_TEXT_IN_NODES        Change Description of Node Name in Trees                    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_KONV_CHANGE_BAPI          Set KONV Change in BAPI (Currency Change)                   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_PRICING_COMPLETE          Deactive/control PRICING_COMPLETE                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Set Reference Fields                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SORT_DOCUMENTS_REPORT_PROCESS Sort Documents for Report Processing                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I SWU_OBJECT_PUBLISH            Publish Business Object                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA2     I VENDOR_CUSTOMER_CHECK         Enhancement: Allowed Customer/Vendor Combinations           .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA3     I DATA_ADOPTION_SETTREQUEST_LISTData Transfer of Sttlmnt Rqst Lst Hdr from Prelim. Entry    .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA3     I DATA_ADOPTION_SETT_LIST_ITEM  Data Transfer of Settlmt Rqst List Itm from Prelim. Entry   .
IF_EX_WLF_ADDITIONAL_DATA3     I SETTLEMENT_LIST_CREATE_CHECK  Check Document Relevancy for Settlement Request List        .
IF_EX_WLF_API_DATA_CHECK       I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Check Header Data Before Data Transfer                      .
IF_EX_WLF_API_DATA_CHECK       I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Check Item Data Before Data Transfer                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ARCHIVE              I CAN_DOC_BE_ARCHIVED           Archive document?                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ARCHIVE              I CAN_REGLST_WBRK_BE_ARCHIVED   Document in Settlement Request List Ready for Archiving     .
IF_EX_WLF_ARCHIVE              I DEL                           Delete Data from Database During Deletion Run               .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_AFTER_DOCUMENT_READ    Adjust Data After Reading the Document                      .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_1   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Vendor Invoice        .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_2   Adjust Data Before Outputting Remuneration Lists            .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_3   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Listing Items         .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_4   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Single Regulation Docs.
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_5   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Posting Lists         .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_6   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Tax Information       .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_7   Adjust Data Before Outputting Regulation Lists              .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_8   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Customer Settlements  .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ              I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_9   Adjust Data Before List Output Vendor Settlement            .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_AFTER_DOCUMENT_READ    Adjust Data After Reading the Document                      .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_1   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Vendor Invoice        .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_2   Adjust Data Before Outputting Remuneration Lists            .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_3   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Listing Items         .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_4   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Single Regulation Docs.
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_5   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Posting Lists         .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_6   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Tax Information       .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_7   Adjust Data Before Outputting Regulation Lists              .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_8   Adjust Data Before Outputting List of Customer Settlements  .
IF_EX_WLF_AT_READ_INT          I CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_OUTPUT_9   Adjust Data Before List Output Vendor Settlement            .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_ADD_NEW_ITEMS  Enhance BAPI Reguli Data Before ADD_NEW_ITEMS               .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CANCEL         Enhance BAPI Data Before Deletion                           .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CANCEL_REGULI  Enhance BAPI Reguli Data Before Deletion                    .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CHANGE         Enhance BAPI LF Data Before Change                          .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CHANGE_BULI    Enhance BAPI Buli Data Before Change                        .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CHANGE_REGU    Enhance BAPI Regu Data Before Change                        .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CHANGE_REGULI  Enhance BAPI Reguli Data Before Change                      .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CHANGE_REMUN   Enhance Remuneration List Data Before Change                .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CLOSE          Enhance BAPI Data Before Completion                         .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_COPY_AND_ADD   Enhance BAPI Data Before Copy and Enhance                   .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CREATE         Enrich LF Data Before Creation                              .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CREATE_REGU    Enhance Regu Data Before Create                             .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_CREATE_REGULI  Enhance Reguli Data Before Create                           .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_ENHANCE         I ENHANCE_BEFORE_REOPEN         Enahnce BAPI Data Before Reopening                          .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_GETDETAIL       I AGENCY_DATA_ENHANCE           Enhance Agency Business Data Before Filling BAPI Structures .
IF_EX_WLF_BAPI_GETDETAIL       I FILL_KOMLFPA_FROM_DOCUMENT    Fill Partner Data from Agency Document                      .
IF_EX_WLF_CHECK_WBTYPE         I CHECK_WBTYPE                  Check Preliminary Posting                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_CONTRACT_CHECK       I CHECK_CONTRACT                Check if Contract Exists                                    .
IF_EX_WLF_CONTRACT_DISPLAY     I DISPLAY                       Display Document                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_CHANGE_DIALOG            Address Change Online                                       .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_COPY                     Copy Address (for Attachment with Reference)                .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_CREATE_BAPI              Transfer Address in BAPI Case                               .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_DELETE                   Delete Address Again (During Entry)                         .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_DISPLAY_DIALOG           Address Displayed Online                                    .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I ADDR_INPUT_DIALOG             Address Entered Online                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_CPDK_HANDLING        I FILL_ACCFI                    Enter Address Data for FI Update                            .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Checks Before Saving                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I CREATE_CHECK                  Check Complaints Creation                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I DISPLAY_REFERENCE_DOCUMENT    Display Complaints Document                                 .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I PROCESS                       Process Complaint                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I REOPEN                        Reopen Complaint                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_CWB                  I STATUS_CHANGE_CHECK           Check If Possible to Change Status                          .
IF_EX_WLF_DELTA_STATISTICS     I DELTA_DOC_UPDATE              Update of Individual Documents                              .
IF_EX_WLF_DOCUMENT_INDEX       I CREATE                        Generate Document Index                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_DOCUMENT_INDEX       I PRICING                       Set Changeable Conditions                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_ENTRY_PREP       I SETTLEMENTREQSTLIST_ENTRY     Prepare entry of settlement request list                    .
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_ENTRY_PREP       I SINGLESETTLEREQST_LIST_ENTRY  Prepare list entry of settlement request                    .
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_ENTRY_PREP       I SINGLESETTLEREQST_SINGLE_ENTRYPrepare single entry for settlement request                 .
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_INDEX_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check if the document is relevant for the document index    .
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_INDEX_CHECK      I REPRICING_CHECK               Check if a document adjustment is possible for this document.
IF_EX_WLF_DOC_INDEX_ENHANCE    I CHANGE_MCKONAI_FOR_DOCUMENT   Change Index Data for Document                              .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS          Change Tab Control Label                                    .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I GET_FCODE                     Get Function Code                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I RESET_INACTIVE_TABSTRIBS      Tab Is Important for Document Processing                    .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I SET_FCODE                     Set Function Code                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I SET_HEADER_DATA               Transfer Header Data                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ENHANCE_SCREENS      I SET_ITEM_DATA                 Transfer Item Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_EXPENSE_ACTIVE       I IS_EXPENSE_ACTIVE             Check If Expense Management Is Active                       .
IF_EX_WLF_FILTER_ENHANCE       I FILTER_EXTEND                 Supplement Fields                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I CHANGE_NODES_BEFORE_DISPLAY   Change Nodes Before Display                                 .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I CHANGE_PF_STATUS              Change Status                                               .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I GET_FLOW_CHANGE               Manipulate Document Flow Display?                           .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I HANDLE_DOUBLE_CLICK           Double-Click Node                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process User-Specific Function Codes                        .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I IS_FI_READ_OFF                Do Not Read Any FI Documents?                               .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I SELECT                        Read Document Flow                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_FLOW_TREE            I SET_SCREEN_FOR_NODE           Set User-Specific Subscreen for Node                        .
IF_EX_WLF_ID_OBJECT_CUSTOMER   I ID_OBJECT_ENTRY               ID Object Entered                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ID_OBJECT_MATERIAL   I ID_OBJECT_ENTRY               ID Object Entered                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_ID_OBJECT_VENDOR     I ID_OBJECT_ENTRY               ID Object Entered                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I CHANGE_CONTROL_RECORD         Change Control Record                                       .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_CUSTOMER_SEGMENENTS_ITEM Fill Customer-Specific Segments At Item Level               .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_CUSTOMER_SEGMENTS_HEAD   Fill Customer-Specific Segments At Header Level             .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_HEADER_TEXTS             Fill Header Texts                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_ITEM_TEXTS               Fill Item Texts                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK01          Fill Segment E1EDK01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK02          Fill Segment E1EDK02                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK03          Fill Segment E1EDK03                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK04          Fill Segment E1EDK04                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK05          Fill Segment E1EDK05                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK14          Fill Segment E1EDK14                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK18          Fill Segment E1EDK18                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDKA1          Fill Segment E1EDKA1                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP01          Fill Segment E1EDP01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP02          Fill Segment E1EDP02                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP03          Fill Segment E1EDP03                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP04          Fill Segment E1EDP04                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP05          Fill Segment E1EDP05                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP19          Fill Segment E1EDP19                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP26          Fill Segment E1EDP26                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDPA1          Fill Segment E1EDPA1                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDS01          Fill Segment E1EDS01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REG2       I GET_AGENCY_DATA               Data Collection                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I CHANGE_CONTROL_RECORD         Change Control Record                                       .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_CUSTOMER_SEGMENENTS_ITEM Fill Customer-Specific Segments At Item Level               .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_CUSTOMER_SEGMENTS_HEAD   Fill Customer-Specific Segments At Header Level             .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_HEADER_TEXTS             Fill Header Texts                                           .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_ITEM_TEXTS               Fill Item Texts                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK01          Fill Segment E1EDK01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK02          Fill Segment E1EDK02                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK03          Fill Segment E1EDK03                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK04          Fill Segment E1EDK04                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK05          Fill Segment E1EDK05                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK14          Fill Segment E1EDK14                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDK18          Fill Segment E1EDK18                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDKA1          Fill Segment E1EDKA1                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP01          Fill Segment E1EDP01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP02          Fill Segment E1EDP02                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP03          Fill Segment E1EDP03                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP04          Fill Segment E1EDP04                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP05          Fill Segment E1EDP05                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP19          Fill Segment E1EDP19                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDP26          Fill Segment E1EDP26                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDPA1          Fill Segment E1EDPA1                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I FILL_SEGMENT_E1EDS01          Fill Segment E1EDS01                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_INVOICE01_REGU       I GET_AGENCY_DATA               Data Collection                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_MASS_CHANGE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_MASS_CHANGE_INV Changes Before Mass Change to Billing Documents Called      .
IF_EX_WLF_MASS_CHANGE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_MASS_CHANGE_PAYLChanges Before Mass Change to Posting List Called           .
IF_EX_WLF_MASS_CHANGE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_MASS_CHANGE_REGUChanges Before Mass Change to Payment Documents Called      .
IF_EX_WLF_MASS_CHANGE          I CHANGE_BEFORE_MASS_CHANGE_REMUChanges Before Mass Change to Remuneration List Called      .
IF_EX_WLF_MASS_CHANGE          I CHANGE_CHANGEABLE_FIELDS      Adjust Changeable Fields                                    .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGES_ENHANCE     I CHECK_DATA_PRINT_INV          Adjust Print of Single Document via SAPScript               .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGES_ENHANCE     I CHECK_DATA_PRINT_INV_L        Adjust Print of List Documents via SAPScript                .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGES_ENHANCE     I MESSAGE_CHANGE                Change Output                                               .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGES_ENHANCE     I MESSAGE_LIST_OUTPUT           Output Message List                                         .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGES_ENHANCE     I PREPARE_OPEN_FORMULAR         Adjust Print Control                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_MESSAGING            I CHECK_MESSAGING_NECESSARY     Call Message Determination for Document Where Necessary     .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I AT_END_PROCESSING             Change Aggregated Item Data on Completion                   .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I CHANGE_AFTER_READ             Change Data After Reading                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I CHANGE_FINALLY                Make Final Changes to Data                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I CHANGE_PARAMETERS             Adapt Parameters                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I CHECK_ENTRY_CUST              Is Customer-Specific Aggregation Active?                    .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I GET_DATA_AFTER_PRINT          Makes Data Available After Printing                         .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I MODIFY_NEW_ENTRY              Change New Entry in the Aggregation Table                   .
IF_EX_WLF_NAST                 I VERIFY_COMPRESS_ITEM_CUST     Check Compressed Entry                                      .
IF_EX_WLF_NUMBER_CHANGE        I CHANGE_NUMBER_RANGE_OBJECT    Change Number Range Object                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_NUMBER_CHANGE        I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Change Number Range                                         .
IF_EX_WLF_PAOBJNR              I HANDLE_PAOBJNR_CHK            Handling PAOBJNR: Characteristic Combination Already Exists .
IF_EX_WLF_PAOBJNR              I HANDLE_PAOBJNR_SET            Handling PAOBJNR:: Copy New PAOBJNR                         .
IF_EX_WLF_PAOBJNR              I REFRESH                       Refresh                                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_PARTNER_CHANGE       I AFTER_PARTNER_CHANGE          Adapt data to partner change                                .
IF_EX_WLF_PARTNER_CHANGE       I CHANGE_PARAMETERS             Adapt Parameters                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_PARTNER_DETERM       I DETERMINE_KUNRG               Determine Payer                                             .
IF_EX_WLF_PARTNER_DETERM       I DETERMINE_LNRZB               Determine Different Payment Recipient                       .
IF_EX_WLF_PORTAL               I BSP_GET_DEFAULT_CC            Determine Company Code for LO_AB_MASTERDTA                  .
IF_EX_WLF_PORTAL               I LIST_OUTPUT_ENHANCE           Format List Output                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_PORTAL               I LIST_OUTPUT_SELECT_OPTIONS    Adjust Selection Data for List Output                       .
IF_EX_WLF_PRICING_REFRESH      I DO                            Reset Pricing Data                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I DEQUEUE_PROCESS               Cancel Process                                              .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I DEQUEUE_PROCESS_ALL           Unlock All Processes                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I ENQUEUE_PROCESS               Lock Process                                                .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I ENQUEUE_PROCESS_ALL           Lock All Processes                                          .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I PROCESS_ENQUEUE_CHECK         Check If Process Lock Exists for Single Document            .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I PROCESS_ENQUEUE_CHECK_MULTIPLEMass Check for Process Lock for Single Documents            .
IF_EX_WLF_PROCESS_ENQUEUE      I READ_ENQ_FOR_CHECK_MULTIPLE   Read Lock Table for PROCESS_ENQUEUE_CHECK_MULTIPLE          .
IF_EX_WLF_REGU_TAX_COMPARE     I REGU_TAX_COMPARE              Check Control Consistency                                   .
IF_EX_WLF_REPORT_PROCESS       I CHANGE_DATAB_DATBI            Set posting date                                            .
IF_EX_WLF_REPORT_PROCESS       I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Customer-Specific FCode                             .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Change Before Saving                                        .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I CHECK_RRLCG_RELEVANT          Check Relevance of Condition Type Group                     .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I CHECK_WBRR_UPDATE             Check WBRR Updat for Pro Forma Remuneration Lists           .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I ENHANCE_LIST_SIM_2            Enhance Output of Simulation List 2                         .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I GET_POSSIBLE_RRLCOND          Determine Possible Remuneration List Condition Types        .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I GET_RRLREC                    Determine Remuneration List Recipient                       .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I GET_WFDAT_RL                  Determine Remuneration List Date                            .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I INVOICE_LIST_CREATE_CHECK     Create Renumeration List, If Possible Check                 .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I SELECT_RRLCOND                Determine Remuneration List Conditions                      .
IF_EX_WLF_RRLE_ENHANCEMENT     I SELECT_RRLCOND_PREFETCH       Determine Remuneration List Conditions: Prefetch            .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_CUSTOMERS                 Determine Customers for Block Processing                    .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_CUSTOMERS_2               Determine Bill-to Party For Block Processing                .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_DATA_FOR_REF_NUMBER       Check Duplicate Entries                                     .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_DATA_FOR_SEL_OPTIONS_1    Data Procurement for Agency Documents                       .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_DATA_FOR_SEL_OPTION_2     Data Procurement for Agency Documents                       .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_DATA_FOR_SEL_OPTION_3     Data Procurement for Agency Documents                       .
IF_EX_WLF_SELECT_DATA          I GET_VENDORS                   Determine Vendor for Block Processing                       .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Adjust Data for Statistics' Update                          .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_DELTA_BEFORE_UPD       Adjust Data During BW Delta Update                          .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_MCWBRK_POST_PARTY      Adjust MCWBRK for Posting Partner                           .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_MCWBRP_POST_PARTY      Adjust MCWBRP for Posting Partner                           .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_SIGNS_MCWBRK           Change +/- Signs in MCWBRK                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_SIGNS_MCWBRL           Change +/- Signs in MCWBRL                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_SIGNS_MCWBRP           Change +/- Signs in MCWBRP                                  .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_2         I CHANGE_SIGNS_MCWBRP_ITEMCAT   Change +/- Signs in MCWBRP for ITEMCAT                      .
IF_EX_WLF_STATISTICS_GT        I UPDATE_EXPENSE_DOC            Update Expense Documents to BW                              .
IF_EX_WLF_TRANSFER_DATA_SL_SR  I TRANSFER_DATA_SL_TO_SR        Transfer Data from Settlement Request List to Single Docs.  .
IF_EX_WLF_TRANSFER_DATA_SL_SR  I TRANSFER_DATA_SR_TO_SL        Transfer Data from Single Doc. to Settlement Request List   .
IF_EX_WLF_TRANSFER_DATA_SL_SR  I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_KOMLFL       Transfer Data to Settlement Request List Item               .
IF_EX_WLF_TXJCD                I DETERMINE_TXJCD               Determine Tax Jurisdiction Code                             .
IF_EX_WM_DSD_ENHANCEMENT       I CHECK_EXT_ACTIVE              Check if Extension is active                                .
IF_EX_WM_DSD_ENHANCEMENT       I TO_CREATE                     Update decision in TO creation                              .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I DCC_DOC_CREATE                Create dynamic cycle count by material inventory document   .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I DCC_DUPLICATES_CHECK          Prevent duplicate materials in dynamic count by material    .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I DCC_TO_CONFIRM                Handle dynamic cycle count documents after TO confirmation  .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I DECISION_UPDATE               Update decision with the actual picked quantity             .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I DELIVERY_SKIP                 Skip or adjust quantity of outbound delivery item in XDOCK  .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TO_CANCEL                     Update decision with TO foreground cancel                   .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TO_CONFIRM                    Update decision in TO confirmation                          .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TO_CREATE                     Update decision in TO creation                              .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TO_PREPARE                    Analyze cross dock in TO preperation                        .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TO_RESET                      Update decision with TO reset                               .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TR_CHANGE                     Update relevant decisions / VAS Orders in TR change         .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TR_COMPLETE                   Update decision with TR completion                          .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TR_CREATE                     Create relevant VAS Orders in TR create                     .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TR_DELETE                     Update relevant decisions in TR deletion                    .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I TR_SKIP                       Skip or adjust quantity of outbound TR item in XDOCK        .
IF_EX_WM_ENHANCMENT            I XDOCK_DOCUMENTS_LOCK          Lock decision and dependent document in TO confirmation     .
IF_EX_WOC_FL_DETERMINE         I ILOA_GET_READING_TIME         Determine Date for Determining Installation Location of Equi.
IF_EX_WOC_FL_DETERMINE         I ILOA_GET_READING_TIME_NOT     Notification:Determine Date for Determining Installation Loc.
IF_EX_WORKBREAKDOWN_UPDATE     I AT_SAVE                       Save WBS, time: Online                                      .
IF_EX_WORKBREAKDOWN_UPDATE     I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Save WBS, time: before posting                              .
IF_EX_WORKLOAD_STATISTIC       I ADD_STATISTIC                 Add New Statistics Records                                  .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_CONFIRM        I AT_CANCEL_CHECK               Confirm Order, Time: Check if Cancellation is Possible      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_CONFIRM        I AT_SAVE                       Confirm Order, Time: Dialog                                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_CONFIRM        I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Confirm Order, Time: Before Update                          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_CONFIRM        I IN_UPDATE                     Confirm Order, Time: Update                                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_DOCLINKS       I MAINTAIN_DOCLINKS             Document Link Maintenance                                   .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I APPROVE                       Execution Steps:  Check for Individual Validated License    .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I CHANGED                       Execution Steps: Check if changes have been made            .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I CONCATENATE                   Connect Execution Steps to existing Execution Steps         .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I CONTROL_RECIPE                Create Control Recipe                                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I COPY                          Copy Execution Steps                                        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I CREATE                        Create Execution Steps                                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I DELETE                        Delete Execution Steps                                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I DISPLAY                       Display Execution Steps                                     .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I EDITOR                        Call Execution Steps Editor                                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I ENQUEUE                       Lock Execution Steps                                        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I EXISTS                        Execution Steps for Header: Check Existence                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I REFRESH                       Remove Execution Steps from Memory                          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_EXEC_STEPS     I UPDATE                        Update Execution Steps                                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I CHANGE_SETTLE_ALLOWED_CHECK   Check Whether Change to Settlement Rule is Allowed          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I COMPLETE_IOMAMO               Fill Valuation Data in the Structure IOMAMO                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I DELETE_BUFFER                 Delete Buffer Tables                                        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I DISPLAY_SETTLEMENT_BUTTON     Deactivate Jump to Maintenance Dialog                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I ORDER_CLOSE                   Check/Set/Revoke Closure/Completion                         .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I ORDER_COSTS_DISPLAY           Display Costs Analysis                                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I ORDER_DEL_FLAG                Check/Set/Undo Deletion Flag                                .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I ORDER_DEL_IND                 Set Deletion Indicator                                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I SETTLEMENT_COPY               Copy Settlement Rules                                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I SETTLEMENT_EDIT               Maintain Settlement Rules                                   .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I SETTLEMENT_MAINTAIN           Create and Update Settlement Rules                          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_FINANCIALS     I SETTLEMENT_SAVE               Save Settlement Rules                                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I BACKFLUSH                     Confirmation: Backflush                                     .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I COGI_AUTHORITY_CHECK          Postprocessing: Authorization Check                         .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I COGI_POST                     Postprocessing of Incorrect Goods Movements                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I GM_SCREEN_LINE_CHECK          Goods Movement Overview: Line Check                         .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I GM_SCREEN_OKCODE_CHECK        Goods Movement Overview: OK Code Check                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I GOODS_RECEIPT                 Confirmation: Automatic Goods Receipt                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I IM_CALLED                     Time after Inventory Management is Called                   .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I MANUAL_GOODS_RECEIPT          Manual Goods Receipt for Order                              .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_GOODSMVT       I PICKLIST                      Pick list                                                   .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I AT_OUTPUT_SCREEN              Is called for every action on the output list               .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I AT_OUTPUT_SCREEN_LAY          Call When Action is Carried Out on the Output List          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN           Is called in the WBS for the PPIO_ENTRY selection screen    .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I DETAIL_LIST_LAY               Process Detail Lists                                        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I ORDER_TABLES_MODIFY           Processing of order tables                                  .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I OVERVIEW_MODIFY               Processing of the object overview                           .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I OVERVIEW_TREE_LAY             Process Layout-Based Object Overview                        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I PLANNED_ORDER_TABLES_MODIFY   Processing of planned order tables                          .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_INFOSYSTEM     I TABLES_MODIFY_LAY             Processing of Order and Planned Order Tables                .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_REWORK         I GET_REWORKED_QUANTITY         Returns the Reworked Yield                                  .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_TAB_SCEM       I ACTIVATE_TAB_PAGE             Activate the Additional Tab Pages                           .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_TAB_SCEM       I PASS_OKCODE_TO_SUBSCREEN      Transfer Current Function Code to Subscreen                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_TAB_SCEM       I TRANSFER_DATA_FROM_SUBSCREEN  Data Transfer: Subscreen Data back to Order                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_TAB_SCEM       I TRANSFER_DATA_TO_SUBSCREEN    Data Transfer: Delivery Data to Subscreen                   .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I ARCHIVE_OBJECTS               Archiving Additional Objects                                .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I AT_DELETION_FROM_DATABASE     Order is deleted from the database (archiving)              .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I AT_RELEASE                    Release Order Time: After SAP Checks, Before Release        .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I AT_SAVE                       Save Order Time: Dialog                                     .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I BEFORE_UPDATE                 Save Order Time: Before Calling Update                      .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I CMTS_CHECK                    Check: Configurable Warehouse Order Allowed                 .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization when Importing/Creating Order                .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I IN_UPDATE                     Save Order Time: Update                                     .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I NUMBER_SWITCH                 Swap Tempory Order Numbers with Final Order Numbers         .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I REORG_STATUS_ACTIVATE         Reorganization of Order: Follow-Up Action After Status Set  .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I REORG_STATUS_ACT_CHECK        Reorganization of Order: Status Check                       .
IF_EX_WORKORDER_UPDATE         I REORG_STATUS_REVOKE           Reorganization of Order: Follow-Up Action After Status Reset.
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I GL_POSTINGS_SELECT            Selection of Available Postings in General Ledger           .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I GL_POSTING_ENRICH_HEADER      Manipulation of Posting Header                              .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I GL_POSTING_ENRICH_ITEM        Manipulation of Posting Items                               .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I GL_POSTING_TABLE_MANIPULATE   Manipulation of Postings Before the BAPI Call               .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I ITS_CONTEXT_MANIPULATE_PAI    Manipulation of ITS Context at Time of PAI                  .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I ITS_CONTEXT_MANIPULATE_PBO    Manipulation of ITS Context at Time of PBO                  .
IF_EX_WOSCR_CBL                I ITS_CONTEXT_POSTINGS_PBO      Manipulation of ITS Context at Time of PBO                  .
IF_EX_WOSCR_EXI                I GL_AMEND_POSTING              Manipulation of Posting Header                              .
IF_EX_WOSCR_EXI                I ITS_CONTEXT_MANIPULATE_PAI    Manipulation of ITS Context at Time of PAI                  .
IF_EX_WOSCR_EXI                I ITS_CONTEXT_MANIPULATE_PBO    Manipulation of ITS Context at Time of PBO                  .
IF_EX_WOSZ_AUTH                I EXTENDED_CHECK                Enhancement of the Authorization Check                      .
IF_EX_WOSZ_MAT_SHOW            I PBO_BEGIN                     Setting of ITS Context                                      .
IF_EX_WOSZ_MAT_SHOW            I USER_CMD_BEGIN                Evaluation of ITS Context                                   .
IF_EX_WOSZ_MAT_SHOW            I USER_CMD_CHECK                Checking and Rejecting Messages                             .
IF_EX_WPLG_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Checks: Layout                                .
IF_EX_WPLG_MAP                 I INDEX_COMPUTE                 Determine Material Valuation Index                          .
IF_EX_WPOS_TIMEDEP_WRSZ_I      I SCAN_TIMEDEP_WRSZ             WRSZ scanning for POS download                              .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I ADD_PRICE_LIST_LEVEL          Check Promotion Discounts at Price List Level for Store     .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I GET_PRICE_LIST_LEVEL          Get Promotion Discounts at Price List Level for Mat. Group  .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I IDOC_DATASET_ARTSTM_APPEND    Fill New IDoc Segments                                      .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I IDOC_PROMREB_APPEND           Add New Segment Fields from Promotion Discounts             .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I MATGRP_ANALYSE_POINTER        Article Hierarchy: Change Pointer Analysis                  .
IF_EX_WPOS_X_POSOUT001_I       I MODIFY_ORGTAB_FOR_DOWNLD      Adjust Events for Downloading AH Assignments                .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I ACTIVE_CHECK_WPS_CC           Check Whether CC or WPS Active                              .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I CHECK_CHANGE_OF_FL            Check of Change of Functional Location                      .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I CHECK_CHANGE_OF_REVNR         Check of Change of Revision Number                          .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I NOTIFICATION_CLOSE            Notification Completion for MEB-Controlled Notifications    .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I REVISION_DATES                Copy Deadlines from Revision                                .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I RIAUFK20_SELECT               Select orders via WPS cross reference for core order reports.
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I ROUTING_EXPLOSION             Deviating Logic for Task List Explosion                     .
IF_EX_WPS_CONNECTION           I VIQMEL_REVNR                  Check the Revision Number                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I CHECK_COMPLETENESS            Verify that all the attributes are filled correctly         .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I MAP_GENERIC_PRICAT_ATTR       Map PRICAT generic attrib. to planned article dynamic attrib.
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I READ_DYNAMIC_ATTRIBUTE        Load the dynamic attributes                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I SELECT_QUOTA_SCALE            Determine which quota scale will be applied                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I SET_ARTICLE_NUMBER            Set the article number (Generic, Variant, Prepack, Etc)     .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ARTICLE_E      I VALIDATE_DYNAMIC_ATTRIBUTE    Validate the dynamic attributes                             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_DIALOG_E       I ADJUST_DYN_ATTRIBUTES         Adjust the dynamic attr. that were added via the customizing.
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_DIALOG_E       I GET_ASORT_DETAIL              Adjust the assortment - store - DC information              .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_DIALOG_E       I GET_CHARACTERISTIC_AXLE       Determine the characteristic position on the ALV Grid       .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_DIALOG_E       I GET_CNT_STORES                Get number of stores                                        .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_DIALOG_E       I MODIFY_ASORT_COLUMNS          Set the title and sequence of asort. cols. across all grids .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ITEMATTR_E     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get objects reference for the BAdI implementation           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ITEMATTR_E     I GET_TABSTRIP_LABEL            Initialize the tabstrib icon and text label                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_ITEMATTR_E     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Send objects reference to the BAdI implementation           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_ARTICLE_AFTER_MAPPING  Change Planned Article Data Before Price Maintenance        .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_ARTICLE_BEFORE_UPDATE  Change Planned Article Data Before Posting                  .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_CDT_BEFORE_UPDATE      Change Article Hierarchy Data Before Posting                .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_PRICAT_MAPPING         Change Mapping of PRICAT Data Before Posting                .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_PURCH_BEFORE_UPDATE    Change Purchasing Data Before Posting                       .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PAREL_E        I CHANGE_SALES_BEFORE_UPDATE    Change Sales Data Before Posting                            .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLCHK_E        I CHECKS_ON_ENTRY_SCREEN        Customer-specific Verifications on the Entry Screen of OAPC .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I LOAD_DYNAMIC_ATTRIBUTES       Load values of dynamic attributes into the ALV grid         .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I ON_USER_COMMAND               Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I SET_STYLE                     Defines additional formatting for an ALV grid line          .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I UPDATE_DYNAMIC_ATTRIBUTES     Update an attribute that was added dynamically to the ALV   .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLISTALV_E     I UPDATE_FCATALOG               Add dynamic attributes to the ALV grid field catalog        .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLITEM_E       I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Do extra check consistencies at the item level              .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLITEM_E       I DISTRIBUTE_QUANTITIES         Distribute the planned quantities to the subsequent levels  .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLITEM_E       I PREVENT_UPDATE_ASSIGNMENT     To prevent the update of assigned quantities                .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLITEM_E       I PREVENT_UPDATE_PLANNED_QTY    To prevent the update of planned quantities                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLLIST_E       I CHANGE_ARTICLE_DATA           Change Material Data Before Saving Listing Conditions       .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLLIST_E       I CHANGE_BEFORE_LISTING_UPDATE  Change Generated Listing Conditions Before Saving Them      .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLREL_E        I CHANGE_AFTER_AL_SELECTION     Change Data After Selection For Allocation Table Generation .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLREL_E        I CHANGE_BEFORE_AL_TRANSFER     Change Data Before Transfer To Allocation Table Generation  .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PLREL_E        I CHANGE_BEFORE_POL_UPDATE      Change Data Before Updating Purchase Order List             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPASGN_E       I LOCK_FOR_INPUT                Lock unwanted prepack assignments for input                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPASGN_E       I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPASGN_E       I ON_USER_COMMAND               Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPDEFN_E       I ADJUST_QUOTA_SCALE_CALCULATIONAdjust the quota scale calculation                          .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPDEFN_E       I LOCK_FOR_INPUT                Lock unwanted prepack components (variants) for input       .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPDEFN_E       I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PPDEFN_E       I ON_USER_COMMAND               Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PREPACK_E      I CALCULATE_PURCHASING_PRICE    Calculate the purchase price of a prepack article           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_PREPACK_E      I SET_DEFAULT_DESCRIPTION       Build default descriptions for the prepack                  .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_SELLTGH_E      I FIND_SELL_THROUGH             Returns PL Item IDs to be incorporated into current PL      .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGETDT_E     I DISTRIBUTE_INBOUND_TOTAL      Distribute the inbound interface total values               .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGETDT_E     I IS_FILLED                     Check if the target data detail table is already filled     .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGETDT_E     I SAVE_TARGET_DATA_DETAIL       Save the target data in DB table WRF_APC_IBID               .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ADD_TARGET_PRICES             Add lines in the target data display grid                   .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ADD_TARGET_QTY                Add lines in the target data display grid                   .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I GET_ARTICLE_TOTAL             Calculates the article total                                .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ON_PRICE_TOOLBAR              Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ON_PRICE_USER_COMMAND         Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ON_QTY_TOOLBAR                Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_TARGTALV_E     I ON_QTY_USER_COMMAND           Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_VARASGN_E      I ADJUST_QUOTA_SCALE_CALCULATIONAdjust the quota scale calculation                          .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_VARASGN_E      I LOCK_FOR_INPUT                Lock unwanted variant assignments for input                 .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_VARASGN_E      I ON_TOOLBAR                    Add additionnal functions on the ALV grid toolbar           .
IF_EX_WRF_APC_X_VARASGN_E      I ON_USER_COMMAND               Process added functions on the ALV grid toolbar             .
IF_EX_WRF_ART_MASS_MAIN_E      I CHECK_FIELD_MAINTAINANCE      Check Whether a Field Can Be Maintained                     .
IF_EX_WRF_ART_MASS_MAIN_E      I CHECK_FIELD_VALUE             Check Whether a Field Value Is Correct                      .
IF_EX_WRF_ASORT_LOCATION_I     I GET_NUMBER                    Issue Internal Assortment Number                            .
IF_EX_WRF_ASORT_REDUCE_E       I ASORT_REDUCE                  Reduce (Change) Transferred Asortment Date                  .
IF_EX_WRF_ASORT_WRS1_DELTAB_I  I FILL_DEL_TAB_WRS1             Write Deletion Table                                        .
IF_EX_WRF_ASORT_WRSZ_DELTAB_I  I FILL_DEL_TAB_WRSZ             Write Deletion Table                                        .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I ADD_ON_FUNCTIONALITY_01       AddOn Function Assortment Header Data                       .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I CHECK_UPDATE_ADD_FIELDS       Check Which Fields of WRS1 Are to Be Updated                .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I FB_MAP2E_WRS1_TO_BAPIE1WRS1   Mapping Header Data in the FM MAP2E_WRS1_TO_BAPIE1WRS1      .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I FB_MAP2I_BAPIE1WRS1_TO_WRS1   Mapping Header Data in the FM MAP2I_BAPIE1WRS1_TO_WRS1      .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I PROCESS_CHECKS                Checks for Additional Fields That Are Processed             .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTMENT_BAPI      I SET_WRS1_DATAE                Set Change Date in Table WRS1                               .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTYP_CHECK_E     I ASSORTYP_CHECK                Customer-Specific Check of Assortment Type in Dialog        .
IF_EX_WRF_ASSORTYP_F4_E        I ASSORTYP_F4                   Search Help Restriction for Field "Assortment Type"         .
IF_EX_WRF_AT_ENH_BEFORE_POST   I ALLOC_ENH_BEFORE_SAVE         Additions (External) Before Saving the Allocation Table     .
IF_EX_WRF_AT_SYNC_PO           I AT_SYNC_PO                    Break Down Changed DC Data to Allocation Table Item         .
IF_EX_WRF_BADIPRE_POST_MAT     I PRICAT_PRE_POSTING_PROCESS    Format Update Structures and Trigger Updating               .
IF_EX_WRF_BUDG_X_KEY_E         I WRF_GET_KEY_FIELD_GEN         Determine Key Fields for WRF_GET_KEY_ID_GEN                 .
IF_EX_WRF_BUDG_X_KEY_E         I WRF_GET_KEY_FIELD_MAT         Determine Key Fields for WRF_GET_KEY_ID_MAT                 .
IF_EX_WRF_BUDG_X_KEY_E         I WRF_GET_KEY_ID                Override Budget Determination in WRF_BUDG_GET_KEY_ID_MA     .
IF_EX_WRF_BUDG_X_KEY_E         I WRF_GET_UNIQUE_KEY_ID         Determine Unique Budget Number                              .
IF_EX_WRF_BUDG_X_TYPE_E        I WRF_BUDG_TYPE_CHECK           Test Whether Budget Type Is Valid for Given Import Parameter.
IF_EX_WRF_CHAR_PROFILE_I       I CHAR_PROFILE_SELECT           Display Characteristic Profiles in Tree Form                .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I ALLOCATE_REMAIN_AFTER_BF      Distribute Remaining Quantity after Stock Determination     .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I ALWAYWS_STOCK_DET_RETURN      Stock Determination for All Returns Items                   .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I CHANGE_ERROR_HNDL_RETURN      Error Handling for Returns Items                            .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I CHANGE_STOCK_SITU_MULTI       Change Return Values for Ambiguous Materials                .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I CHANGE_STOCK_SITU_RESULT      Change Return Values for Structured Materials               .
IF_EX_WRF_CONSIGNMENT_CUST     I GET_STOCK_TYPE_STRUCT_ART     Determine Stock Category for Structured Materials           .
IF_EX_WRF_CT04_CHARVAL_I       I CALL_WRFCHVAL                 Call New Characteristic Value Maintenance (Retail)          .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I ADAPT_AL_CHANGE_DATA_DIALOG   Check and Adapt Material List Data                          .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I ADAPT_AL_CREATE_DATA_DIALOG   Default Setting for Creating ML                             .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I EDIT_AL_OF_OTHER_USER         Edit Another User's Material List                           .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I REFRESH_TABLE_DISPLAY         Settings for ALV Resulting Quantity                         .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I SET_LEADTIME_BEFORE_DEL       Define Lead Time Prior to Deletion                          .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Settings for ALV Resulting Quantity                         .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_AL_E            I SET_TODATE_OFFSET             Offset to First TO Date                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_CHARVALUES      I CHECK_CUSTOMER_VALUE          Dialog Check for Customer Values                            .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_CHARVALUES      I GET_VALUE_REQUEST             Search Help for Customer Values                             .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_CHARVALUES      I TRANSFORM_CHAR_VALUES         Key Conversion in Customer Fields                           .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I CHECK_CHANGES                 Customer-Specific Checks of Changes                         .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I CHECK_MAINTENANCE_FIELDS      Customer-Specific Checks after Defining Maintenance Fields  .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I CHECK_MAINTENANCE_GRID        Customer-Specific Checks Within Maintenance Grid            .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I CHECK_SELECTION               Customer-Specific Checks After Dynamic Selection            .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I CHECK_SELECTION_CRITERIA      Customer-Specific Checks After Choosing Selection Criteria  .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I PREPARE_POSTING               Customer-Specific Checks Before Update                      .
IF_EX_WRF_CUST_SPEC_CHK        I PREPARE_SELECTION             Customer-Specific Checks Before Dynamic Selection           .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_CUST_E       I CHECK_CUST_SCREEN             Perform Checks of Customer Subscreen                        .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_CUST_E       I FILTER_DISCONT_ENTRIES        Filter Worklist Items for Discontinuation                   .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_CUST_E       I GET_CUST_SCREEN               Define Customer Subscreen                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_EINA                  Follow-Up Actions in Vendor/Material Discontinuation        .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MARA                  Follow-Up Actions in Client-Wide Material Discontinuation   .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MARC                  Execute Follow-Up Actions f. Discontinuation of MARC Segment.
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MARD                  Execute Follow-Up Actions f. Discontinuation of MARD Segment.
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MBEW                  Execute Follow-Up Actions f. Discontinuation of MBEW Segment.
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MLGN                  Execute Follow-Up Actions f. Discontinuation of MLGN Segment.
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MLGT                  Execute Follow-Up Actions f. Discontinuation MLGT Segment   .
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_FACT_E       I PROCESS_MVKE                  Execute Follow-UP Actions f. Discontinuation of MVKE Segment.
IF_EX_WRF_DISCONT_PARAMS_I     I GET_PARAMS                    Read Discontinuation Parameter                              .
IF_EX_WRF_DYNAMIC_SELECT_E     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Import Selection Criteria from Customer Program             .
IF_EX_WRF_DYNAMIC_SELECT_E     I LOAD_PROGRAM                  Customer-Specific Program/Screen Selection Criteria         .
IF_EX_WRF_DYNAMIC_SELECT_E     I PROCESS_FCODE                 Processing the Function Code of the Selection Screen        .
IF_EX_WRF_DYNAMIC_SELECT_E     I PROCESS_SELECTION             Customer-Specific Selection or Restriction of Parameters    .
IF_EX_WRF_DYNAMIC_SELECT_E     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Export Selecton Criteria to Customer Program                .
IF_EX_WRF_FOLUP_ACTION_E       I FOLLOW_UP_ACTION              Follow-Up Actions                                           .
IF_EX_WRF_FOLUP_CHECK_E        I CHECK_FOLUP                   Validation Checks for Follow-Up/Repl. Mat. Relationships    .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I CHECK_HIERARCHY_HEADER        Check Changed Hierarchy Data                                .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I GET_DEFAULT_TREE_OBJECT       Pass On TREE_MODEL Instance                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I MODIFY_NEW_HIERARCHY_DATA     Modify Hierarchy Data (Creation)                            .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Field Control                                               .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I NODE_CTX_MENU                 Define Context Menu                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I PROCESS_FCODE                 Process Custom Function Codes                               .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I SET_EVENT_HANDLER_FOR_TREE    Program-Specific Event Handler                              .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I UPDATE_DEFAULT_SETTINGS       Revise Default Settings                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_E       I UPDATE_TREE                   New and/or Deleted Nodes                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I CHECK_HIERARCHY_HEADER        Check Changed Hierarchy Data                                .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I GET_DEFAULT_TREE_OBJECT       Pass On TREE_MODEL Instance                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I MODIFY_NEW_HIERARCHY_DATA     Modify Hierarchy Data (Creation)                            .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Field Control                                               .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I NODE_CTX_MENU                 Define Context Menu                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I PROCESS_FCODE                 Process Custom Function Code                                .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I SET_EVENT_HANDLER_FOR_TREE    Program-Specific Event Handler                              .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I UPDATE_DEFAULT_SETTINGS       Revise Default Settings                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_GENERIC_HIER_I       I UPDATE_TREE                   New and/or Deleted Nodes                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I CHECK_MODUS                   Adjust ALV Processing Mode                                  .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I GET_GLOBAL_PARAMETER          Define Global Control Parameters                            .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I MODIFY_HEADER                 Modify Screen Structure                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I MODIFY_STATUS                 Deactivate GUI Status Functions                             .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I NODE_DATA_CHANGED             Check Changed Node Extension Data                           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I NODE_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED    Check Changed Node Extension Data                           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I OBJECT_DATA_CHANGED           Check Changed Object Data                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I OBJECT_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED  Check Changed Object Data                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I POST_DATA                     Call Before Saving Changed Hierarchy Data                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I REFRESH_NODES_DISPLAY         Node/Mode Change: ALV Grid for Node Extension               .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I REFRESH_OBJECTS_DISPLAY       Node/Mode Change: ALV Grid for Object Maintenance           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I SET_NODES_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Initialize ALV Grid for Node Extension                      .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_E       I SET_OBJECTS_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY Initialize ALV Grid for Object Maintenance                  .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I CHECK_MODUS                   Adjust ALV Processing Mode                                  .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I GET_GLOBAL_PARAMETER          Define Global Control Parameters                            .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I MODIFY_HEADER                 Modify Screen Structure                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I MODIFY_STATUS                 Deactivate GUI Status Functions                             .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I NODE_DATA_CHANGED             Check Changed Node Extension Data                           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I NODE_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED    Check Changed Node Extension Data                           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I OBJECT_DATA_CHANGED           Check Changed Object Data                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I OBJECT_DATA_CHANGED_FINISHED  Check Changed Object Data                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I POST_DATA                     Call Before Saving Changed Hierarchy Data                   .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I REFRESH_NODES_DISPLAY         Node/Mode Change: ALV Grid for Node Extension               .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I REFRESH_OBJECTS_DISPLAY       Node/Mode Change: ALV Grid for Object Maintenance           .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I SET_NODES_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Initialize ALV Grid for Node Extension                      .
IF_EX_WRF_GEN_HIER_ALV_I       I SET_OBJECTS_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY Initialize ALV Grid for Object Maintenance                  .
IF_EX_WRF_LMF_FIXID_AUTO_E     I GET_NEW_FIXTURE_ID            Determine a New Free Fixture ID                             .
IF_EX_WRF_LV_CHECK_E           I LV_CHECK                      Check of Listing Procedures                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_LV_F4_E              I LV_F4                         Search Help Restriction for "Listing Procedure" Field       .
IF_EX_WRF_MAPINB_X_MODIF_E     I MODIFY_MSG_ASRTPLN            Modify Assortment Plan message before updates               .
IF_EX_WRF_MAPINB_X_MODIF_E     I MODIFY_MSG_ASRTPRDVRS         Modify Assortment Product Version message before updates    .
IF_EX_WRF_MAPINB_X_MODIF_E     I MODIFY_MSG_LOCGRP             Modify Location Group message before updates                .
IF_EX_WRF_MAPINB_X_MODIF_E     I MODIFY_MSG_MDPROP             Modify Markdown Proposals message before updates            .
IF_EX_WRF_MAPINB_X_MODIF_E     I MODIFY_MSG_PRODUCT            Modify Product message before updates                       .
IF_EX_WRF_MATGRP_X_DLD         I ADD_SEGMENT                   Generate Segment E1WAH03 for Customer Exits                 .
IF_EX_WRF_MATGRP_X_DLD         I MODIFY_SPRAS                  Modify Language Key to Read                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I CREATE_ADDITIONAL_DATA        Generate Additional Segments                                .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I GET_EXCLUDED_FIELDS           Determine Fields Not Relevant for Copying                   .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_ADDITIONAL_DATA        Check/Adjust Additionals                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_BOM_DATA               Check/Adjust BOM Data                                       .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_CALCULATION_DATA       Check/Adjust Pricing                                        .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_CONDITION_DATA         Check/Adjust Condition Data                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_GENERAL_DATA           Check/Adjust General Material Data                          .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_HIERARCHY_DATA         Check/Adjust Article Hierarchy Assignment                   .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_INFORECORD_DATA        Check/Adjust Purchasing Info Record                         .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_LISTING_DATA           Check/Adjust Listing Condition                              .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_REPLENISHMENT_DATA     Check/Adjust Replenishment Data                             .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_REQUIREMENT_GROUP_DATA Check/Adjust Requirement Groups                             .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_SOURCE_LIST_DATA       Check/Adjust Source List                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTAINDATA     I MODIFY_VENDOR_CHARACTERISTICS Check/Adjust Vendor Material Characteristic Values          .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I ACTIVATE_EXTENSION            Activate FCODE and Subscreen Processing                     .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I CHECK_DATA_BEFORE_DIALOG      Check/Change Data Before Sending Main Screen                .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I CHECK_DATA_BEFORE_POSTING     Check/Change Data Before Update                             .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I CHECK_FCAT_FOR_VARIABLE_DATA  Check/Change the Column Text/Item                           .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I GET_CUSTOM_DATA_OBJECT        Customer-Specific Data Object / Update                      .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          NOT NEEDED                                                  .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I PROCESS_FCODE_01              Process Function Code +CUS_01                               .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I PROCESS_FCODE_02              Process Function Code +CUS_02                               .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I PROCESS_FCODE_03              Process Function Code +CUS_03                               .
IF_EX_WRF_MAT_MAINTENANCE      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Transfer ALE Instance to Subscreen                          .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_B1_B2_E        I WRF_MPA_X_B1_B2_DATA          BAdI Method for Data Selection/Worklist Interface           .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_B1_B2_E        I WRF_MPA_X_FIELD_CATALOGUE     BAdI Method for Field Catalog of ALV Grid "Worklist"        .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_B1_B3_E        I WRF_MPA_X_B1_B3_DATA          BAdI Method Data Selection/Profile Assignment Interface     .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_B2_B3_E        I WRF_MPA_X_B3_DATA             BAdI Method Data Modification Block 3 (Profile Assignment)  .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_B2_B3_E        I WRF_MPA_X_B3_FIELD_CAT        BAdI Method Block 3 (Profile Assignment) Field Catalog      .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_CHCKAUT_E      I WRF_MPA_X_CHECK_AUTHORITY     BAdI Method for Authority Check                             .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_CHCKCON_E      I WRF_MPA_X_CHCKCON_E           BAdI Method for Modification of Consistency Check           .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_MPA_UPD_E      I WRF_MPA_MODIFY_PROFILES       BAdI Method for Modifying Assignments to Update             .
IF_EX_WRF_MPA_X_MPA_UPD_E      I WRF_MPA_READ_PROFILES         BAdI method to Read Assignments to Update                   .
IF_EX_WRF_MRM_ASSIGN_TEST      I DATES_REDETERMINE             Change Date of First Assignment Test                        .
IF_EX_WRF_MRM_ASSIGN_TEST      I INVOICE_SAVE                  Change Result of Assignment Test (Before Saving)            .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_COC_E         I WRF_EVAL_BEDAT                Latest Order Date for FB WRF_PCON_EVAL_BEDAT                .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_COC_E         I WRF_EVAL_EXTRAPOL             Extrapolation for FM WRF_PCON_EVAL_EXTRAPOL                 .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_INRAT_E       I WRF_CHECK_CONTRACT            Check Contract                                              .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_INRAT_E       I WRF_EVAL_IR_DISTRIBUTE        Determ. alloc. of contract value-qty to intern.contr.apport..
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_INRAT_E       I WRF_EVAL_OTB_KEY_MATKL        Determ. of OTB Buckets for Material Group Contract Items    .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_INRAT_E       I WRF_EVAL_PRICE                Determination of Individual Contract Values                 .
IF_EX_WRF_PCON_X_INRAT_E       I WRF_GET_OFFSET                Determined Offset f. Internal Contract Apportionment Surplus.
IF_EX_WRF_PCTR_X_GRAPHIC_E     I GRAPHIC_CUSTOMIZE             Change Graphic Layout                                       .
IF_EX_WRF_PCTR_X_GRAPHIC_E     I GRAPHIC_DATA_CHANGE           Change Data for Graphical Display                           .
IF_EX_WRF_PLANT_MAPPING        I MAP_PLANTS                    Convert Group of Plants                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_POLCTR          I WRF_POHF_POL_GETCONTR_X       Implementation of Customer-Spec. Logic for Contract Determ. .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_POLCTR          I WRF_POHF_POL_GETPRICE_X       Realization of Customer-Specific Logic for Price Determ.    .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_POL_INBOUND     I WRF_POHF_POL_CHECK_X          Implementation of Customer-Specific Checks in Order List    .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_POL_INBOUND     I WRF_POHF_POL_MSG_BST_X        Implementation of Customer-Specific Confirmations PurchOrd. .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_POL_INBOUND     I WRF_POHF_POL_MSG_X            Implementation of Customer-Specific Confirmations           .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_HEAD          Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Header Data       .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_HEADG         Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Header Data GPO      .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POL           Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Order List Items     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POSCHE        Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Item Data for PO     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POSCHEG       Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Item Data GPO        .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I CREATE_FIELDCAT_HEAD          Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Header Data   .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I CREATE_FIELDCAT_HEADG         Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of Header Data GPO  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POL           Statistic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Order List Items   .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POSCHE        Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Item Data     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_UI              I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POSCHEG       Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of GPO Item Data    .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_VAR_COPY        I WRF_POHF_CHANGE_LGORT         Change Storage Location                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_VAR_COPY        I WRF_POHF_CHANGE_PSTYP         Change Item Category                                        .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_ENHANCEMENT_E I INBOUND                       Inbound Mapping                                             .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_ENHANCEMENT_E I OUTBOUND                      Outbound Mapping                                            .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_GROUP_ITEMS   Implementation of Customer-Specific Criteria for GRP Process.
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_GROUP_PO      Implementation of Customer-Specific GPR Check for Pur.Doc.  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_GROUP_VAR     Implementation of Customer-Specific GRP Check for Variants  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_PO_CREATION   Implementation of Mapping of PO List Items to Vendor Order  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_STO_CREATION  Implementation of Mapping of Vendor Order to Stock Transfer .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MOD_CHECKED_SUBMI    Implementation of Customer Check of Assigned Collective No. .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MOD_CREATED_SUBMI    Implementation of Customer Assignment of Collective Number  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_GROUP_E       I WRF_POHF_MOD_SUBMI_RELEVANT   Real. Cust.-Spec. Check f. Relevance of Collective Numbering.
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_POLCTR_E      I WRF_POHF_POL_GET_CONT_X       Implementation of Customer-Spec. Logic for Contract Determ. .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_STLOC_E       I WRF_POHF_MODIFY_STLOC_DATA    Realization of a Customer-Spec. Storage Loc. Determination  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_HEAD          Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Header Data       .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_HEADG         Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Header Data GPO      .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POL           Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Order List Items     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POSCHE        Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Item Data for PO     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ADJUST_FIELDCAT_POSCHEG       Dynamic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Item Data GPO        .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I ASSORT_ITEM                   List Material in Plant on Specified Date                    .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I CREATE_FIELDCAT_HEAD          Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Header Data   .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I CREATE_FIELDCAT_HEADG         Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of Header Data GPO  .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POL           Statistic Adjustment of Field Catalog of Order List Items   .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POSCHE        Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of PO Item Data     .
IF_EX_WRF_POHF_X_UI_E          I CREATE_FIELDCAT_POSCHEG       Statistical Adjustment of Field Catalog of GPO Item Data    .
IF_EX_WRF_POTB_X_VALUE_E       I GET_VALUE_AFTER               Determination of OTB-Relev. Values in Module WRF_POTB_VALUE .
IF_EX_WRF_POTB_X_VALUE_E       I GET_VALUE_BEFORE              Determination of OTB-Relev. Values in Module WRF_POTB_VALUE .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_CALCULATION      I CALCITEM_ENHANCE              Extend Pricing Item                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_BG_STAT_E      I DET_BG_DET_SUM_STAT           Budget Status -"Budget Monitor Detailed View                .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_BG_STAT_E      I DET_BG_INFO_STAT              Budget Status -" Budget Monitor Overview                    .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_BG_STAT_E      I DET_BG_STAT_ORDER             Budget Status Order                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_BUDG_TXT_E     I BUDG_TEXT_CREATE              Create Long Texts for Budgets                               .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_BW_QULTY_E     I CHECK_BW_DATA_QUALITY         Check the Data Quality of the POS Sales Data                .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_MESSAGES_E     I SORT_MESSAGES                 Process Log Messages for the Price Planning Workbench       .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_POS_READ_E     I POS_DATA_READ                 Read POS Sales Data                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_REL_ART_E      I GET_BASE_FROM_RELATED_ARTICLE Determine Basic Material for Related Markdown Proposal      .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_REL_ART_E      I GET_RELATED_ARTICLES          Determine Related Markdown Proposals                        .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_SELECT_E       I ARTCONT_DATA_SELECT           Filter Selection Set for Articles                           .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_SELECT_E       I GET_SUBSCREEN_NR              Set Program and Subscreen for Selection Screen Enhancement  .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_STAT_SET_E     I SET_STATUS_FOR_APPROVAL       Set Workflow Relevance for Budgets and Status upon Release  .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_STOCK_E        I MODIFY_STOCK_QUANTITY         Change Stock Quantity Determined for Material/Plant         .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_TREE_TXT_E     I GET_RELATED_TEXT              Define Node Texts for Nodes in PPW Worklist                 .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_WL_RLART_E     I GET_OLD_RELATED_ARTICLES      Determine Old, Related Markdown Proposals                   .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_WL_RLART_E     I SET_REL_ART_FLAG_IN_WL        Flag Markdown Proposals with "Related Exist"                .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_WORKLIST_E     I INSERT_WORKLIST               Process Markdown Proposals During Worklist Generation       .
IF_EX_WRF_PPW_X_WORKLIST_E     I MODIFY_WORKLIST               Process Markdown Proposals During Enrichment                .
IF_EX_WRF_PRCT_X_CAT_PRIO      I CATEGORIZE_AND_PRIOR          Determines Activity Folder and Priority                     .
IF_EX_WRF_PREPAY_INVOICE       I PREPAYMENT_RELEVANCE_CHANGE   Override Prepayment FLag                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_PREPAY_INVOICE       I SET_POSTING_DATE              Change Posting Date of Prepayment Document                  .
IF_EX_WRF_PRGRP_MERCHCAT_E     I PRGRP_MANDATORY_CHECK         Checks Whether PRGRP Is Required or Optional Input          .
IF_EX_WRF_PRGRP_T023_SCR_I     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Retrieve Data from Subscreen                                .
IF_EX_WRF_PRGRP_T023_SCR_I     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Provide Data on Subscreen                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_COND_POST     I CHECK_PURCHASE_CONDITION      Checks if a purchasing condition is to be posted            .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_COND_POST     I CHECK_SALES_CONDITION         Checks if a sales condition is to be posted                 .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DELETION      I CHECK_CATALOGUE               Check Catalog Before Deletion                               .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DELETION      I CHECK_POSITIONS               Check Items Before Deletion                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DIALOG        I ADDITIONAL_DATA               ALV Output Tables: Include Customer-Specific Data           .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DIALOG        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DIALOG        I FIELDCATALOG_CHANGE           Add Further Fields to ALV Field Catalog                     .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_DIALOG        I UPDATE_ITEM_SUBOBJECTS        Refresh the Item Subobject (for Example, Text)              .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_IN_CUST       I CHECK_PROFILE_AND_MATGRP      Check If Char. Profile and Material Group Are Suitable      .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_IN_CUST       I DETERMINE_CHAR_PROFILE        Determine Characteristics Profile                           .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_POOL          I CHANGE_PRICE                  Change Price Data Before Price Determination                .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_POOL          I EXTEND_ARTICLE_MASTER         Enhance Material Master Data                                .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_POOL          I SAVE_CATALOGUE                A Catalog Is Saved in the POOL                              .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_POOL          I SAVE_ITEM                     An Item Is Saved in the POOL                                .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_REENGINEER    I MESSAGE_REENGINEER            Read Messages and Revise as Necessary                       .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_SORT          I GET_SORTFIELD                 Return Customer-Specific Sort Field for an Item             .
IF_EX_WRF_PRICAT_SORT          I GET_SORTRULES                 Return Sort Rules                                           .
IF_EX_WRF_PROC_STATUS_1        I GET_PROC_STATUS_1             Check PROC_STATUS of Item (PRICAT_K003-PROC_STATUS)         .
IF_EX_WRF_PROC_STATUS_2        I GET_PROC_STATUS_BOM_KOMPONENTSCheck PROC_STATUS of Item (PRICAT_K003-PROC_STATUS)         .
IF_EX_WRF_PSCD_X_CHG_DL_E      I CHANGE_DATELINE               Change Date Line                                            .
IF_EX_WRF_PSCD_X_C_DFLT_E      I CHANGE_DEFAULT_DISTANCE       Change Default Interval for Autom. Date Shift               .
IF_EX_WRF_PSCD_X_C_DIST_E      I CHANGE_DATELINE_ITEMS         Change Date Line Before Calculation                         .
IF_EX_WRF_PSCD_X_DAT_CAL_E     I DATE_CALCULATION              Change of Date Line After Calculation                       .
IF_EX_WRF_REF_BADI             I CHANGE_TARGET_ASSIGNMENT      Change reference assigment during copy function in dial. pr..
IF_EX_WRF_REF_BADI             I DETERMINE_REFERENCES          Implementation of Reference Determination type 'BAdI'       .
IF_EX_WRF_REF_BADI             I GET_SITE_LIST                 Select plants using BAdI in dialog program                  .
IF_EX_WRF_RPR_INT_PLGRP        I SUGGEST_PLGRP_NAME            Name Assignment for Local Plant Groups                      .
IF_EX_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_NAME       I SET_NAME_AFTER_CREATION       Name Assignment After Creation of Plant Group               .
IF_EX_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_NAME       I SET_NAME_BEFORE_CREATION      Name Assignment Upon Creation of Plant Group                .
IF_EX_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_NAME       I SET_NAME_DEREFERENCING        Name Assignment Upon Conversion of Class. System to Local   .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_ADDCHECK_E      I ADDITIONAL_CHECK              Additional Checks Against Assortment Structure              .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_CAPA_CHECK      I CHANGE_FIX_ASGMT_CAPACITY     Change Fixture Capacity During Check                        .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_CAPA_CHECK      I CHANGE_FIX_LENGTH_CHECK       Intervention in Check on Fixture Length (Fx DIM 02)         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_CAPA_CHECK      I CHANGE_FIX_QUANTITY_CHECK     Intervention in Check on Number of Materials (Fx DIM 01)    .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_CAPA_CHECK      I CHANGE_FIX_VOLUME_CHECK       Intervention in Check on Fixture Volume (Fx DIM 03)         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_CHG_ART_S_E     I CHANGE                        Change to Version-Specific Versions                         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_EXT_WMSBA       I CHANGE_DATA                   Transfer of Data To Be Displayed                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_EXT_WMSBA       I CHANGE_LAYOUT                 Transfer of Presentation Data                               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_LIST_DIFF_I     I CHANGE_DATAB                  Change DATAB within WSOH                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_LMVF_SC_E       I DATA_CHANGE                   Modification of Import Data                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT1_E     I GET_SELECTION_DATA            Get Selection Data from Class                               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT1_E     I GET_TAB_LABEL                 Read Button Text                                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT1_E     I SET_SELECTION_DATA            Transfer of Selection Data to Class                         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT2_E     I GET_SELECTION_DATA            Get Selection Data from Class                               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT2_E     I SET_SELECTION_DATA            Transfer of Selection Data to Class                         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT3_E     I GET_MEINH                     Returns Units of Measure That Are Not Displayed             .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT4_E     I ADD_CUST_FIELD_VALUES         Add Customer-Spec. Field Values                             .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_WLWBNEXT4_E     I CHANGED_FRONTEND_SETTINGS     Change Layout, Field Catalog, and Sort Sequence             .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_AR_AV_X       I SET_OSPS_FLAG                 Select the Relevant Article                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_AR_OSPS_X     I SET_OSPS_FLAG                 Select the Relevant Article                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_CONV_QUAN     I GET_QUANTITY                  Delivers the Optimal Shelf Quantity                         .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_FIXREAD_E     I READ_DATA                     Change Data Before Return                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_FIX_CHG_E     I CHANGE_DATA                   Change Data                                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LIST_VZ       I CHANGE_LISTING_DATA           Change/Add to Listing Data                                  .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF1_E       I CHANGED                       Sets the Changed Data Records                               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF1_E       I COPY                          Copies a Fixture                                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF1_E       I GET_TABSTRIP_LABEL            Set Description of Tab Strip                                .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF1_E       I REFRESH                       Refresh the Customer Application                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF1_E       I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF2_E       I CHANGED                       Sets the Changed Data Records                               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF2_E       I COPY                          Copies a Fixture                                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF2_E       I GET_TABSTRIP_LABEL            Set Description of Tab Strip                                .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF2_E       I REFRESH                       Refresh the Customer Application                            .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF2_E       I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF3_E       I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Data Transfer from Impl. Class                              .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF3_E       I GET_TITLE_FOR_SCREEN          Title of Selection Screen                                   .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF3_E       I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Data Transfer to Impl. Class                                .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LMVF4_E       I GET_URL                       Returns an Image URL for a Particular Fixture               .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_LM_LT_E       I DO_REDIRECT                   Forwarding of New Transactions                              .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WAREPL_E      I GET_NEW_MATNR                 Returns New Material for Replacement                        .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WLAM_1_E      I GET_DISPLAY_OPTIONS           Read the Start Options                                      .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_1_E      I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_2_E      I CHANGE_DATA                   Change data                                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_3_E      I CHANGE_DATA                   Change data                                                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_4_E      I CALL_CUSTOMER_SELECTION       Enhancement: Flexible Time Selection of Transaction Data    .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_4_E      I CUSTOMER_BW_DATA_READ         Enhancement: Flexible Time Selection of BW Data Procurement .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_LOG      I ADD_AND_SAVE_LOG_ENTRIES      Saving Error Protocol                                       .
IF_EX_WRF_WLAY_X_WPLG_LOG      I ADD_LOG_ENTRIES               Adding Further Entries to Error Protocol                    .
IF_EX_WRF_WLWB_CUST            I DISPLAY_HIER_NODE             Output of Hierarchy Node in LWB                             .
IF_EX_WRF_WLWB_CUST            I DO_CAPA_CHECK                 Activate/Deactive Check on Fixture Capacity                 .
IF_EX_WRF_WLWB_CUST            I MAX_ALLOWED_SELECTED_MATNR    Max. Number of Materials To Be Selected                     .
IF_EX_WRF_WTAD_CA_REPORT       I WRF_WTAD_X_ALV_DATA           BAdI Method : Data Modification                             .
IF_EX_WRF_WTAD_CA_REPORT       I WRF_WTAD_X_ALV_FIELDCAT       BAdI Method : Change Field Catalog                          .
IF_EX_WRF_WTAD_EXP_ADDI_E      I ALLOCATE_NEW_DEL_ADDI         Transfer Deleted or New WTADAB Data                         .
IF_EX_WRF_WTAD_PREPARE_AD      I WRF_WTAD_PREPARE_ADDI_DATA    BAdI Method for Changing Selected Data                      .
IF_EX_WRF_WTAD_REDUCE_ADDI     I POSITIONS_TO_DELETE           Returns Rows to Be Deleted from Table                       .
IF_EX_WRF_X_ASLIST_UPD1_I      I SCAN_WRSZ                     Interval Scan of WRSZ Assignments                           .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_AH_SCREEN_I     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_1104     Data Transportation                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_AH_SCREEN_I     I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN_130      Data Transportation                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_AH_SCREEN_I     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_1104       Data Transportation                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_AH_SCREEN_I     I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN_130        Data Transportation                                         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_ARTH_I          I GET_HIERARCHY_NODE_FOR_AT     Determine a Node in the Article Hierarchy                   .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_CHECK_E         I CHECK_ALLOCATION_TABLE        Checks/Log in Allocation Table                              .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_DET_EADAT_I     I GET_SLS_REL_FOR_AT            Determine SLS Relevance                                     .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_FDG_E           I MESSAGES_DETERMINE            Determine Messages                                          .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_GRID_DISPL      I CHANGE_GRID_LINE              Method for Changing Displayed Data (Item Row)               .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_GRID_DISPL      I SET_FIELDCAT_GRID             Methods for Changing the Field Catalog in the Grid          .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_LIST_LOC_E      I LIST_DETERMINE_DATE_SITE      Change Listing Period (Listing from Allocation Table)       .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPL      I CHANGE_HEAD_LINE              Method for Changing Displayed Data (Header)                 .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPL      I CHANGE_POS_LINE               Method for Changing Displayed Data (Item Row)               .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPL      I SET_FIELDCAT                  Method for Changing Field Catalog for Column Set            .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPLAY    I CHANGE_HEAD_LINE              Method for Changing Displayed Data (Header)                 .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPLAY    I CHANGE_POS_LINE               Method for Changing Displayed Data (Item Row)               .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_POOL_DISPLAY    I SET_FIELDCAT                  Method for Changing Field Catalog for Column Set            .
IF_EX_WRF_X_AT_SYNC_I          I FEEDBACK_APC                  Feedback                                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_X_CHG_CHECKOPT_E     I CHANGE_CHECKOPT               Check Whether Change of Check Option Is Allowed             .
IF_EX_WRF_X_TRANSIT_STOCK      I ADD_TRANSIT_STOCK_ITEMS       Attach Additional Lines with Type WRF_TRANSFER_STOCK_       .
IF_EX_WRF_X_TRANSIT_STOCK      I COMPLETE_TRANSIT_STOCK_ITEM   Fill Additional Fields of Table WRF_TRANSFER_STOCK_STY      .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I CHECK_OTB_ACTIVATED           Checks if the OTB Check Is Active                           .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I FASHION_GROUP_SUBMI           Collective Number Assignment                                .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I FASHION_INITIAL_DATA          Initialization of the Global Data                           .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I FASHION_PO_CREATE             Creation of Purchase Order with Fashion PO Creation         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I FASHION_PO_PREPARE            Preparation of Fashion PO Creation                          .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I GET_DATE                      Determination of Date RTFASH                                .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I GET_OPTIONS                   Read Parameters from Function Group WRF_WF10_FUGROUP        .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_A1_I          I SET_OPTIONS                   Write Parameters (Function Group  WRF_WF10_FUGROUP)         .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_CUST_E        I MODIFY_MESSAGES               Processing of Messages for Seasonal Procurement (WF10)      .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WF10_PSTYP_E       I GET_PSTYP                     Reading of Item Category                                    .
IF_EX_WRF_X_WRSZ_PHYSDEL_E     I CHECK_WRSZ_TAB                Check Selected WRSZ Entries                                 .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_ARTMAST                Change SAF Outbound Interface ARTMAST (or ARTMASTUPD)       .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_CALENDAR               Change Entries in the Default File CALENDAR.DSX             .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_CONFIG                 Change Entries in CONFIG.INI (Preparation ParamGroup)       .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_DAYSALES               Change SAF Outbound Interface DAYSALES                      .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_DELIVER                Change Entries in the Default File DELIVER.DSX              .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_DELIVSUPPL             Change Entries in the Default File DELIVSUPPL.DSX           .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_EVENTS                 Change SAF Outbound Interface EVENTS                        .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_HISTORY                Change Entries in the Default File HISTORY.DSX              .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_OPENORDER              Change Entries in the Default File OPENORDER.DSX            .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_ORDER                  Change Entries in the Default File ORDER.DSX                .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_PREDINPUT              Change SAF Outbound Interface PREDINPUT                     .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_PUBHOLIDAYS            Change SAF Outbound Interface PUBHOLIDAYS                   .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_SALES                  Change SAF Outbound Interface SALES                         .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_STOCK                  Change Entries in the Default File STOCK.DSX                .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_STOCKRECEIPT           Change Entries in the Default File STOCKRECEIPT.DSX         .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_SUPPLIER               Change SAF Outbound Interface SUPPLIER                      .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_WEEKFCST               Change Entries in the Default File WEEKFCST.DSX             .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CHANGE_WORK                   Change Entries in the Default File WORK..INI                .
IF_EX_WSAF_CHNGE_INTERFACE     I CREATE_NEW_FILE               Creation of a New File                                      .
IF_EX_WSAO_DISP_EXPAND         I DEFINE_HEADERS                Define Headings for Customer Fields                         .
IF_EX_WSAO_DISP_EXPAND         I EXPAND_ITEM                   Add a Line to Customer Fields                               .
IF_EX_WSAO_DISP_FLAGS          I CHANGE                        Change Indicators in MRP List                               .
IF_EX_WSAO_DISP_GROUP          I CHANGE                        Change MRP List                                             .
IF_EX_WSAO_DISP_GROUP          I GROUP_SORT                    Group, Sort MRP List                                        .
IF_EX_WSAO_DYNP                I PBO_BEGIN                     Setting of ITS Context                                      .
IF_EX_WSAO_DYNP                I USER_CMD_BEGIN                Evaluation of ITS Context                                   .
IF_EX_WSAO_DYNP                I USER_CMD_CHECK                Checking and Rejecting of Messages                          .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I FINISH_DATA                   Close Outbound Processing                                   .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I INBOUND                       Inbound Processing                                          .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I MATERIAL_TAB_CREATE           Customer-Specific Material List                             .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I MV_OUTBOUND_DATA              Outbound Processing for Movement Data                       .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I OUTBOUND_CTRL                 Control Parameters in Outbound Processing                   .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I OUTBOUND_DATA                 Outbound Processing for Material and Movement Data          .
IF_EX_WSAO_PDC                 I OUTBOUND_STRUCTURE            Outbound Processing for Structure Data                      .
IF_EX_WSAO_RMAT                I PBO_BEGIN                     Setting of ITS Context                                      .
IF_EX_WSAO_RMAT                I USER_CMD_BEGIN                Evaluation of ITS Context                                   .
IF_EX_WSAO_RMAT                I USER_CMD_CHECK                Checking and Rejecting of Messages                          .
IF_EX_WSRS_MAT_KEY_SRC         I WSRS_MATKEY_PAI_SELECT        Material Search Help: Database Selection                    .
IF_EX_WSRS_MAT_KEY_SRC         I WSRS_MATKEY_PBO_SUBSCREEN     Extension Material Search                                   .
IF_EX_WSTI_BADI_POS_EVENTS     I GET_EVENTS                    Determine POS Transactions                                  .
IF_EX_WSTRN_ALLOC_DIALOG       I COMMAND_TOOLBAR               Process your added functions                                .
IF_EX_WSTRN_ALLOC_DIALOG       I SETUP_PP_TOOLBAR              Set up the prepack allocation ALV grid toolbar              .
IF_EX_WSTRN_ALLOC_DIALOG       I SETUP_VAR_TOOLBAR             Set up the variant allocation ALV grid toolbar              .
IF_EX_WSTRN_DATA_PLANNED       I GET_DATA_PLANNED              Get a style, style/color and style/assortment plan          .
IF_EX_WSTRN_MAP                I MODIFY_EXTRACTION_RANGE       Modify the selection range used to extract MAP information  .
IF_EX_WSTRN_OVERVIEW           I ALLOCATION_OVERVIEW           Create an overview report or make adjustments               .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PPALLOC_POST       I CHANGE_BEFORE_ALLOC_UPDATE    Change allocation data before posting                       .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PPALLOC_POST       I CHANGE_BEFORE_LISTING_UPDATE  Change listing conditions before posting                    .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PPALLOC_POST       I CHANGE_BEFORE_PREPACK_UPDATE  Change prepack data before posting                          .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PPALLOC_POST       I CHANGE_BEFORE_PURCH_UPDATE    Change info records before posting                          .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK            I MODIFY_DESCRIPTION            Modify/Generate the description for the prepack             .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK            I MODIFY_NUMBER                 Modify/Generate the material number for the prepack         .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK            I MODIFY_PURCHASING_PRICES      Modify/Generate the purchasing price for the prepack        .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK_DIALOG     I APPLY_QUOTA_SCALES            Modify the quota scales calculation                         .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK_DIALOG     I COMMAND_TOOLBAR               Process your added functions                                .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK_DIALOG     I GET_QUOTA_SCALES              Read your own quota scale for the row characteristic        .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PREPACK_DIALOG     I SETUP_TOOLBAR                 Set up the prepack ALV grid toolbar                         .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PUTAWAY_DIALOG     I COMMAND_TOOLBAR               Process your added functions                                .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PUTAWAY_DIALOG     I SETUP_PP_TOOLBAR              Set up the prepack put-away ALV grid toolbar                .
IF_EX_WSTRN_PUTAWAY_DIALOG     I SETUP_VAR_TOOLBAR             Set up the variant put-away ALV grid toolbar                .
IF_EX_WSTRN_SITES_FIGURES      I EXTRACT_SITES_KEY_FIGURES     Extract several key figures for each given store            .
IF_EX_WSTRN_STYLE              I GET_VALUE_DESCRIPTION         Get the description of a characteristic value               .
IF_EX_WSTR_CHG_RESTRICTION     I CHECK_DOCUMENTS               Check Use Of Structured Materials In Logistics Processes    .
IF_EX_WSTU_BADI_SEARCHHELP     I CALL_SEARCHHELP               Call Search Help for Date of Price Change                   .
IF_EX_WTAD_ADDI_MON_I          I AM_CHECK_GBB                  Check Additionals Items on Grouped PO Document              .
IF_EX_WTAD_ADDI_MON_I          I AM_SET_USER_GSTAT             Set Separate GUI Status                                     .
IF_EX_WTAD_ADDI_MON_I          I AM_USER_FCODES                Own FCODES in Addi.Monitor                                  .
IF_EX_WTAD_COND_SUPPLY         I WTAD_COND_FORWARD             Storage of Price Information in Data Structure for Addit.   .
IF_EX_WTAD_COND_SUPPLY         I WTAD_COND_STORE               Determination and Temp. Storage of Price Information        .
IF_EX_WTAD_X_WTADAB_E          I FILL_ADDI_INFO                Fill Append Fields for Structure addi_info                  .
IF_EX_WTAD_X_WTADAB_E          I FILL_WTADAB                   Fill Append Fields for Table WTADAB                         .
IF_EX_WTAXREPORT_MODIFY        I ACTIVITIES_AFTER_OUTPUT       Further Activities After Report Output                      .
IF_EX_WTAXREPORT_MODIFY        I ENTER_ADDINFO_BEFORE_SELECTIONEnable the User to Enter Additional Selection Parameters    .
IF_EX_WTAXREPORT_MODIFY        I MODIFY_DATA_BEFORE_OUTPUT     Modify the WH Tax Data Before Output                        .
IF_EX_WTAXREPORT_MODIFY        I MODIFY_FIDOC_BEFORE_OUTPUT    Change the Selected Accounting Document Line Items          .
IF_EX_WTYSC_CLAIM_CONTROL      I CLAIM_CREATION                Control of Claim Creation                                   .
IF_EX_WTYSC_CLAIM_CONTROL      I CLAIM_UPDATION                Control of Claim Updation (New Version of Claim)            .
IF_EX_WTYSC_INDICATOR_SET      I SET_RETURNPART_INDICATOR      Setting the Warranty indicator in components                .
IF_EX_WTYSC_INDICATOR_SET      I SET_WARRANTY_INDICATOR        Setting the Warranty indicator in operations and components .
IF_EX_WTYSC_MAP                I MAP_CLAIM_ORDER_FIELDS        Mapping service order fields to claim bapi fields           .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_DETAILSCR      I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get data from screen                                        .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_DETAILSCR      I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Put data in screen                                          .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_SEL_SCREEN     I GET_ADDITIONAL_SELECTIONS     Get customer selections                                     .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_SEL_SCREEN     I GET_SELECTED_DATA             Fill customer object instances                              .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_VIEW           I CONTEXT_MENU_REQ              Handle context menu request (FCODE starting with Y & Z only).
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_VIEW           I CONTEXT_MENU_SEL              Handle context menu selection                               .
IF_EX_WTYSC_WWB_VIEW           I FILL_TREE_DATA                Fill tree data according                                    .
IF_EX_WTY_BAPI_CREATE          I BAPI_EX_CREATE                BAPIPAREX_T                                                 .
IF_EX_WTY_BAPI_CREATE          I BAPI_EX_CREATE_BEFORE_M       BAPIPAREX_T                                                 .
IF_EX_WTY_BAPI_CREATE          I BAPI_EX_READ                  BAPIPAREX_T                                                 .
IF_EX_WTY_BRF                  I CHANGE_CONTEXT                Change the claim context after BRF run, as per table GB01   .
IF_EX_WTY_BRF                  I GET_EVENT                     Call multiple events                                        .
IF_EX_WTY_BRF                  I SET_CONTEXT                   Pass context for customer data sources                      .
IF_EX_WTY_BRF                  I SET_START_EVENT               Set start event for processing                              .
IF_EX_WTY_BW                   I FILL_HEADER_DATA              Complete Warranty Header                                    .
IF_EX_WTY_BW                   I FILL_ITEM_DATA                Complete Warranty Item                                      .
IF_EX_WTY_BW                   I FILL_RECALL_DATA              Complete Recall Structure                                   .
IF_EX_WTY_BW                   I FILL_VERSION_DATA             Complete Warranty Version                                   .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_IN        I CHANGE_EXPORT_PARAMETERS      Change Export Parameters                                    .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_IN        I CHECK_IDOC                    Check IDoc Controller/Data Record                           .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_IN        I CHECK_PARTNER                 Partner Check if KNA1/LFA1 not Maintained                   .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_IN        I INTERPRET_ADDITIONAL_SEGMENT  Process Extra Segments                                      .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_IN        I INTERPRET_IDOC                Interpret IDoc                                              .
IF_EX_WTY_CLAIM_IDOC_OUT       I CHANGE_SEGMENT                Change Segment / Add New Segments                           .
IF_EX_WTY_COPA_CRITERIA        I COPA_CRITERIA_ADD             Add CO-PA Characteristic                                    .
IF_EX_WTY_COPA_CRITERIA        I COPA_CRITERIA_FILL            Fill CO-PA Characteristics                                  .
IF_EX_WTY_COPA_VALUEFIELDS     I COPA_VALUEFIELDS_FILL         Fill Value Fields CO-PA                                     .
IF_EX_WTY_CREATE_COPY          I DATA_CHANGE_CHANGE            Change of Data after Change in UI / BAPI                    .
IF_EX_WTY_CREATE_COPY          I DATA_CHANGE_COPY              Change of Data after Copying of Versions                    .
IF_EX_WTY_CREATE_COPY          I DATA_CHANGE_CREATE            Change of Data on Creation of Claim                         .
IF_EX_WTY_CREATE_COPY          I DATA_CHANGE_LAST              Change Data After Action Control, Customer Fields           .
IF_EX_WTY_DATA_CHANGE_1        I DATA_CHANGE_1                 Change of Data after Change in UI                           .
IF_EX_WTY_DISPLAY_OBJECT       I SHOW_VEHICLE_DATA             Display Vehicle Data                                        .
IF_EX_WTY_DOCU_FLOW            I ADD_DOCUMENT                  Add Documents                                               .
IF_EX_WTY_DOCU_FLOW            I DOCUMENT_DISPLAY              Display Document                                            .
IF_EX_WTY_DYNPRO_DYNAMIC       I CHANGE_CLAIM_NAVTREE_STRUCTUREModify Navigation Tree Structure                            .
IF_EX_WTY_DYNPRO_DYNAMIC       I CHANGE_FIELDCAT_ITEM          Change Field Catalog Item List                              .
IF_EX_WTY_DYNPRO_DYNAMIC       I CHANGE_LAYOUT_ITEM            Change Field Catalog Item List                              .
IF_EX_WTY_DYNPRO_DYNAMIC       I GET_RELATED_CLAIMS            List of Related Claims for Navigation Tree                  .
IF_EX_WTY_DYNPRO_DYNAMIC       I SET_SCREEN                    Set Screens                                                 .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_DEFECT            I CHANGE_DEFECTCODE             Transfer of F4 Help Values for Defect Catalog               .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_ITMNO             I CHANGE_ITMNO                  Change Key Field                                            .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_MATNR             I CHANGE_MATNR                  Change of Item Data                                         .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_MATNR             I DISPLAY_MATNR                 Display Material Data                                       .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_MGANR             I CHANGE_MGANR                  Master Warranty Number                                      .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_MGANR             I READ_MGANR_MASTER             Read Data for Master Warranty                               .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_RELOB             I CHANGE_RELOB                  Selection Object                                            .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_RELOB             I CHANGE_RELOB_RELTY_MODEL      Selection of Template Objects for Model and Object Type     .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_RELOB             I CHANGE_RELTY_MODEL            Selection Model for Object Type                             .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_RELOB             I MODEL_CHECK                   Model Check                                                 .
IF_EX_WTY_F4_RELOB             I RELOB_MODEL_CHECK             Check Template Objects for Model                            .
IF_EX_WTY_GET_SUPPL_DATA       I MEASUREMENT_POINT_DETERMINE   Determination Measuring Pnts for Entering MeasValue in Claim.
IF_EX_WTY_ITEM_GENERATE        I DETERMINE_ITEMS               Read Structure for Item from Master Data                    .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMB                 I CHANGE_KOMB                   Change Data Account Determination Communication Header      .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMKB_KOMPB          I CHANGE_KOMKCV                 Change Data Account Determination Communication Header      .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMKB_KOMPB          I CHANGE_KOMPCV                 Change Data Account Determination Communication Item        .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMKCV_KOMPCV        I CHANGE_KOMKCV                 Change Data Account Determination Communication Header      .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMKCV_KOMPCV        I CHANGE_KOMPCV                 Change Data Account Determination Communication Item        .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMK_KOMP            I CHANGE_KOMK                   Change Data Pricing Communication Header                    .
IF_EX_WTY_KOMK_KOMP            I CHANGE_KOMP                   Change Data Pricing Communication Item                      .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I AFTER_PROCESSING_CLAIM        After Processing, Before Saving Buffer                      .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I AFTER_PROCESSING_OPERATION    After Checks from Job Definition Are Done                   .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I BEFORE_PROCESSING_CLAIM       After Claim Is Loaded, Before Processing                    .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I BEFORE_PROCESSING_OPERATION   After Predefined Prereq. Are Checked and Before Excution    .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I CUSTOMER_EXIT_OPERATION       Called by Operation "Customer Exit"                         .
IF_EX_WTY_MASS_PROCESSING      I INITIALIZATION                Before Selection                                            .
IF_EX_WTY_POSTING_DATA         I AP_DATA_CHANGE                Change of Creditor Line                                     .
IF_EX_WTY_POSTING_DATA         I AR_DATA_CHANGE                Change of Debtor/Customer Line                              .
IF_EX_WTY_POSTING_DATA         I GL_ACCOUNT_DATA_CHANGE        Change of G/L Account Line                                  .
IF_EX_WTY_POSTING_DATA         I HEADER_DATA_CHANGE            Change of Posting Document Header Data                      .
IF_EX_WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA      I EXTERNAL_BUFFER_REFRESH       Delete Change Request Buffer                                .
IF_EX_WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA      I EXTERNAL_BUFFER_SAVE          Save Data from Buffer to Database                           .
IF_EX_WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA      I MEASUREMENT_POINT_DETERMINE   Determination Measuring Pnts for Entering MeasValue in Claim.
IF_EX_WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA      I REGISTER_IN_BUFFER            Register Customer Object for Buffering                      .
IF_EX_WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA      I WTY_READ_SUPPL_DATA           Read Master Data                                            .
IF_EX_WTY_RECALLS              I GET_RECALL_OBJECT_LIST        Compile List of Recall Objects                              .
IF_EX_WTY_RECALLS              I IS_OBJ_ON_RECALL_OBJECT_LIST  Is the Object on the Recall Object List                     .
IF_EX_WTY_RETURN_PARTS         I RETURNED_PARTS_RECEIPT        Receipt of Parts that Must Be Returned                      .
IF_EX_WTY_SELECTION_LIST       I GET_OBJECT_DEFAULT            Read Object Data                                            .
IF_EX_WVFI_BADI_TIMESTAMPS     I GET_WSTI_OPEN_STORE           Check if Physical Inventory Is Active for Open Store        .
IF_EX_WVFI_BADI_TIMESTAMPS     I SET_TIMESTAMPS                Set Time of Count                                           .
IF_EX_WVFI_BADI_TWPII          I GET                           Pick Up Settings Used                                       .
IF_EX_WVFI_PDC_EVENT           I CREATE_REL_IN                 Generate Entry For Inbound IDoc                             .
IF_EX_WVFI_PDC_EVENT           I CREATE_REL_OUT                Generate Entries For One/Multiple Outbound IDocs            .
IF_EX_WVKU_REV_PROF_ASSIGN     I GET_REVALUATION_PROFILE       Determine Valuation Profile Using Article Data              .
IF_EX_WVLB_BADI_WLB13_EXT      I MODIFY_WBO1_WBO2              Modification for Prot. Table of Simulation List for O. Opt. .
IF_EX_WVMI_X_CHK_MRPTP_E       I CHECK_MRP_TYPE_FOR_SMI        Check Replenishment Type                                    .
IF_EX_WV_KOMK_E                I FILL                          Fill/Change KOMK Fields                                     .
IF_EX_WV_KOMK_V                I FILL                          Fill KOMK Structure                                         .
IF_EX_WV_KOMP_E                I FILL                          Fill/Change KOMK/KOMP Fields                                .
IF_EX_WV_KOMP_V                I FILL                          Fill KOMP Structure                                         .
IF_EX_WV_RPC_COND              I FILL_KOMK_V                   Fill KOMK Structure                                         .
IF_EX_WV_RPC_COND              I FILL_KOMP_V                   Fill KOMP Structure                                         .
IF_EX_WV_SET_CALC_TYPE         I KSTEU_CHANGE                  Compare KOMK, KOMP, if Nec. Adjust Condition Control Indic. .
IF_EX_WV_SET_CALC_TYPE_INT     I KSTEU_CHANGE                  Compare KOMK, KOMP, if Nec. Adjust Condition Control Indic. .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_001             I COMPUTE                       Perform Calculations                                        .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_001             I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_001             I SET_FCODES                    Activate/Deactivate Function Codes                          .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_003             I COMPUTE                       Fill Additional Key Figure                                  .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_003             I INIT                          (Re)Initialize if Necessary                                 .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I ALLOC_CREATE                  Specific Allocation Function                                .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I DELIVERY_WAVES_DC             When Creating a Delivery Phase Distribution Center          .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I DELIVERY_WAVES_PLANT          When Creating a Delivery Phase Plant                        .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I INIT                          Initialization Type                                         .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I POSITION_CREATE               Before Creating an Article Item                             .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_005             I POST_CREATE                   After Saving the Allocation Table                           .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_006             I FILL_INTERFACE                Fills the Interface of Planning Processor                   .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_006             I PROCESS_INTERFACE_AFTER_CALL  For Interpreting Return Parameters After Calling Processor  .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_007             I DEINIT                        Internal Deinitialization When Planning Is Exited           .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_007             I EXECUTE_FCODE                 Run Internal Function Code                                  .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_007             I INIT                          Internal Initialization When Planning Is Started            .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_008             I PROCESS_BEFORE_STORE          Before Planning Data Is Posted                              .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_009             I PROCESS_BEFORE_READ           Before Reading BW Data                                      .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_009             I PROCESS_BEFORE_SAVE           Before Updating MAP Tables                                  .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_010             I SAVE_DATA_PLHIER              Before the Planning Hierarchy is Saved                      .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_011             I CHECK_COMPLETENESS_PLSCH      Checks Completeness of Planning Step                        .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_011             I CHECK_CONSISTENCE_PLSCH       Checks Consistency of Planning Step                         .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_012             I BREAKDOWN                     Run a Breakdown                                             .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_013             I HANDLE_SUM_INPUT              Handling Method for Data Input                              .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_013             I RESET_INIT_STATUS             Resets the Status to "init" for Restructured Total Infos    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_014             I READ_TEXT                     Reread Text                                                 .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_015             I READ_ATTRIBUTE                Upload the Attributes                                       .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I ENQUEUE                       Set Lock                                                    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I FILL_ITAUSPR                  Calculate Value for the ITAUSPR Attribute                   .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I GET_ITDAT1_VALUE              Calculate Value for the ITDAT1 Attribute                    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I GET_ITDAT2_VALUE              Calculate Value for the ITDAT1 Attribute                    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I GET_OP_VALUE                  Calculate Operand Value for Formula Groups                  .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I INIT                          Initial. type                                               .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_016             I SAVE_ATTRIBUTES               Saving the Attributes                                       .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_017             I INIT                          Initial. type                                               .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_017             I LISTUNG_CALL                  Call Listing                                                .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_017             I LISTUNG_EXEC                  Call Listing                                                .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_018             I ADD_OPERAND                   New Operand                                                 .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_019             I CHECK                         Run Check                                                   .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_020             I PROCESS                       Perform Postprocessing                                      .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_021             I PROCESS                       Execute Subsequent Processing                               .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_022             I TRANSPORT_FORM                Enhancement To Layout Connection                            .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_022             I TRANSPORT_PLSZN               Enhancement To Planning Scenario Connection                 .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_023             I GET_DATA_FROM_SCREEN          Get Data From Subscreen                                     .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_023             I INIT                          Initialization When Dialog Box is Called                    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_023             I PUT_DATA_TO_SCREEN            Put Data To Screen                                          .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_024             I CALL_F4                       Call Input Help                                             .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_025             I CHECK_MANIPULATE_LEVEL        Perform Manipulation for Planning Level?                    .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_025             I MANIPULATE                    Perform Manipulation at Record Level                        .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_026             I GET_ATNAM                     Determine Class Characteristic                              .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_030             I LOCK_SET                      Extend the Block                                            .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_031             I DEFINE_DIST_KEY               Definition - Distribution Key                               .
IF_EX_WXP_BADI_031             I GET_DIST_KEY                  Definition - Attribute of Distribution Key                  .
IF_EX_W_RETAILSYSTEM_IDENT     I RETAILSYSTEM_IDENTIFICATION   Identification of a Retail System                           .
IF_EX_W_RTL_ACTIVITIES         I GIVE_ACTIVITIES               Specify Activities and Field Movements                      .
IF_EX_W_RTL_ASSORTM_AREA       I DERIVE_ASSORTMENT_AREA        Derive Assortment Area from Material                        .
IF_EX_W_SMAN_SHIFTPLAN         I SET_STORE_GROUPING            Set Organizational Grouping in Employee List                .
IF_EX_XIR21003                 I GET_RENTALVALUE_IR21          Get  the rental value                                       .
IF_EX_XIR21003                 I GET_SEL_IR21                  Changing the sel-begda, sel-endda values                    .
IF_EX_XIR21003                 I GET_TEMP_IR21                 Changing the temse variables of IR21                        .
IF_EX_XIR8S001                 I GET_SELIR8S                   Changing the sel-begda and sel-endda variables              .
IF_EX_XIR8S001                 I GET_TEMPIR8S                  Passing temse table values.                                 .
IF_EX_XML_DAS_AUTH_CHECK       I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check of the Application                      .
IF_EX_XSS_DATAORIGIN           I GET_RFC_DESTINATION           Determine RFC Connection for an Object                      .
IF_EX_XSS_GRT_SRV_NOSEL        I PROVIDE_OUTPUT                Provides output of application                              .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I DEFINE_PRINTBUTTON_STATUS     Determine Whether Send Output Request Is Supported          .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I PROVIDE_DROPDOWN_ENTRIES      Define Selection List and Additional Info                   .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I PROVIDE_FILTERED_RGDIR        Restrict In Periods Available in ESS                        .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I PROVIDE_OVERVIEWTAB_FIELDCAT  Field Catalg for Overview Table                             .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I PROVIDE_OVERVIEWTAB_LINE      Formatting of Cell Content for a RGDIR Row                  .
IF_EX_XSS_REM_INTERFACE        I PROVIDE_SRVDESCRIPTION        Description: Salary Statement Service on Area Page          .
IF_EX_XSS_TIM_PER_INTERFACE    I PROVIDE_DEFAULT_DATE_RANGE    Default Value for Display of Date                           .
IF_EX_XSS_TIM_PER_INTERFACE    I PROVIDE_DROPDOWN_ENTRIES      Fill Drop-Down List Box                                     .
IF_EX_XSS_TIM_PER_INTERFACE    I PROVIDE_OVERVIEWTAB_FIELDCAT  Field Catalog for Overview Table                            .
IF_EX_XSS_TIM_PER_INTERFACE    I PROVIDE_OVERVIEW_LINE         Formatting of a Row in the Overview Table                   .
IF_EX_XSS_TIM_PER_INTERFACE    I PROVIDE_PERIOD_TABLE          Create Table of All Periods that Can Be Displayed           .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I CREATE_F4_CUST_OBJ            Method for defining a personalization object                .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I GET_PROPERTY_VALUE            Access to class attribute                                   .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I GET_STANDARD_HITLIST          Access to local class                                       .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I SAVE                          Stores the settings                                         .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I SET_DFIES_OPT_COL             Method for mixing optimized representation                  .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I SET_PROPERTY_VALUE            Method for storing "direct" personalization                 .
IF_F4CUSTOM                    I SHOW_F4_PERS_DIALOG           Method for display and entry                                .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR           Gets an Instance of Valuation Parameters                    .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_ITEM_MNGR                 Gets an Instance of Asset Values                            .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_MASTER_DATA_MNGR          Gets an Instance of Asset Master Data                       .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_NEXT_SUBNUMBER            Gets Next Subnumber to Be Assigned                          .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_TD_AMD_MNGR               Gets an Instance of Time-Dependent Asset Master Data        .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I GET_VALUE_MNGR                Gets an Instance of Asset Values                            .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Asset                                           .
IF_FAA_ASSET                   I SET_MASTER_DATA_MNGR          Sets Instance of Asset Master Data                          .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I GET_BUSKEY                    Supplies Business Object Key (BOR-Key) [abstract]           .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I GET_BUSTYPE                   Supplies Business Object Type (BOR Type) [abstract]         .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I GET_CHANGE_DOCUMENT_IDENT     Supplies Object ID for Change Documents                     .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I GET_STORE_DATE                Supplies Time Stamp of STORE to Database [Final]            .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I INIT_BUS_OBJECT               "Only for Factory Methods" [Final]                          .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I LOCK                          Sets Lock                                                   .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I UNLOCK                        Removes Lock                                                .
IF_FAA_BUS_OBJECT              I WRITE_CHANGE_DOCUMENTS        Expanded Treatment of Change Documents                      .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS          I GET_ASSETCLASS_TEXT           Determines Text of an Asset Class                           .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS          I GET_INFO_LOCKED               Checks If Asset Class Is Locked                             .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS          I GET_NUMBERRANGE               Determines Number Range Interval                            .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS_ERP      I GET_LAYOUT_FROM_ASSETCLASS    ERP: Determines the Layout of an Asset Class                .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS_ERP      I GET_NUMBERRANGE_INFO          ERP: Determines Number Data and Internal/External Info      .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS_ERP      I GET_SCR_LAYOUT_AREA           ERP: Determines the Screen Layout of a Depreciation Area    .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS_ERP      I GET_SCR_LAYOUT_RULE           ERP: Determines the Screen Layout of the Asset Class        .
IF_FAA_CFG_ASSETCLASS_ERP      I INITIALIZE                    Default of Public Member Data                               .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA            I COUNT_DELTA_PERIODS           Determines Number of Periods Between 2 Entries              .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA            I GET_DEPRKEY_PERIOD_WEIGHTING  Determines Period Weighting Using Fiscal Year Variant       .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA            I GET_PERIOD_AND_YEAR           Determines Period + Fiscal Yr from Date for Dep.Calculation .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA            I IS_REAL_AREA                  Determines If Depreciation Area Is Real or Derived          .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA_ERP        I GET_CLOSED_FISC_YEAR          ERP: Determines Closed Fiscal Year of Area                  .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRAREA_ERP        I INITIALIZE                    Proposals for Data                                          .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRKEY             I GET_MAX_BASEVALUE             Determines the Maximum Base Value from the Asset Class      .
IF_FAA_CFG_DEPRKEY_ERP         I INITIALIZE                    Proposals for Data                                          .
IF_FAA_CFG_INDEXSERIES_ERP     I INITIALIZE                    Provide Default Values for Data                             .
IF_FAA_CFG_INFLATION_ERP       I INITIALIZE                    Provide Default Values for Member Data                      .
IF_FAA_CFG_INVSUPPORT_ERP      I INITIALIZE                    Proposals for Data                                          .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_FIRST_DAY_IN_PERIOD       Determines First Day in a Period (in Fiscal Year)           .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_FIRST_DAY_IN_YEAR         Determines First Day in Fiscal Year                         .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_LAST_DAY_IN_PERIOD        Determines Last Day in a Period (in Fiscal Year)            .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_LAST_DAY_IN_YEAR          Determines Last Day in Fiscal Year                          .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_LEGACY_STATUS             Gets Information on Status of Legacy Data Transfer          .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_LOCAL_CURRENCY            Gets ISO Code of Local Currency                             .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_MAX_OPEN_FY               Determines Maximum (Open Fiscal Year)                       .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I GET_NUMBER_OF_PERIODS         Determines Number of Periods of Fiscal Year                 .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I IS_ACTIVE                     Checks If Option Is Active Using Incoming Constants         .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ             I IS_PRODUCTIVE                 Leading Object Is Set as Productive                         .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_CHARTOFDEPRECIATION       ERP: Determine Chart of Depreciation                        .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_DEPRKEY_DETAILS           ERP: Determine Default Values for Depreciation Key          .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_DOC_TYPES_PERIOD_PROCESSESERP: Document Types for Periodic Processes                  .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_MAX_CLOSED_FY             ERP: Determines Most Recent Closed Fiscal Year              .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_MIN_CLOSED_FY             ERP: Determines Oldest Closed Fiscal Year                   .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I GET_PERIOD_AND_YEAR           ERP: Determines Period and Fiscal Year for Postings         .
IF_FAA_CFG_LEADOBJ_ERP         I INITIALIZE                    Proposals for Data                                          .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION         I CAPITALIZE_ASSET              Boole: Capitalize Asset                                     .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION         I CHANGEOVER_IS_ACTIVE          Boole: Set Changeover Year in Asset                         .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION_ERP     I ASSETCLASS_ALLOWED            Checks If Transaction Type Is Allowed for Asset Class       .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION_ERP     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Object Generation                         .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION_ERP     I LOAD_AREALIMITATIONS          Loads Any Existing Area Limitations (TABWA)                 .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION_ERP     I LOAD_SPECIAL_RETIREMENTS      Loads Any Existing Special Retirement Handling (TABWU)      .
IF_FAA_CFG_TRANSACTION_ERP     I LOAD_VALUE_ADJUSTMENTS        Loads Any Existing Different TTy Key for Prop.Values (TABWK).
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I PUT_MESSAGE_TO_TABLE          Write Error Message to Error Table                          .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_AREAS                     Specify Areas for Which Values Are to Be Calculated         .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_BADI_HANDLE               Set BAdI Instance                                           .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_FYEAR                     Set Calculation Year                                        .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_HANDLE1                   Set Linked Object                                           .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_HANDLE2                   Set Linked Object                                           .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_HANDLE3                   Set Linked Object                                           .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_PERIOD_TO                 Set To-Period and Date                                      .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_PROCESS                   Set Process                                                 .
IF_FAA_DC_SEGMENTS             I SET_SUBPROCESS                Set Processing Subprocess                                   .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I COPY_FROM_MASTER              Copies Data from a Reference Manager                        .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I GET_COMPLETENESS              Gets Completeness Indicator for Valuation Data              .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I GET_DEPR_AREA_PARAM           Gets Table of Depreciation Terms for Deprec. Calculation    .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_FAA_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR         I SET_DEPR_PARAM                Set Paramters for Depreciation Calculation                  .
IF_FAA_FIELD_RULES             I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_FAA_FIELD_RULES             I GET_FIELD_STATUS              Get Change Status of Field                                  .
IF_FAA_FIELD_RULES             I GET_FIELD_STATUS_CAUSE        Get Reason for Change Status                                .
IF_FAA_FIELD_RULES             I GET_PARALLEL_FIELD            Gets Parallel Field for an Entered Field Name               .
IF_FAA_FIELD_RULES             I INIT_BY_ASSET_MD              Initialize Data with Help of Asset Master Data              .
IF_FAA_GROUP_BOX               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FAA_GROUP_BOX               I IS_ACTIVE                     Is the Group Box Active?                                    .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initialization of Asset Transactions                        .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I PUT_ASSET_TO_MNGR             Add Asset to Instance Management Table                      .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I PUT_ITEMS_TO_BUFFER           Add Line Items to Change Buffer                             .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I REFRESH_ASSET_MNGR            Delete Instance Management Table                            .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I REFRESH_TEMP_ITEM_BUFFER      Delete Temporary Transaction Buffer of a Posted Asset       .
IF_FAA_ITEM_MNGR               I REFRESH_TEMP_ITEM_BUFFER_ALL  Delete Temporary Transaction Buffer for All Posted Assets   .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I COPY_FROM_MASTER_ASSET        Copies Values of Reference Asset (Reference/Main No.)       .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_ASSET_CLASS               Gets Instance of Asset Class of Asset Master Data           .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_DATA                      Gets the Time-Independent Asset Master Data                 .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_DEPR_PARAM_MNGR           Gets an Object from Depreciation Area Parameters            .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_FIELD_RULES               Gets an Object for Interpretation of Screen Layout          .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_NEXT_SUBNUMBER            Gets Next Subnumber to Be Assigned                          .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_SCR_LAYOUT_RULE           Gets Screen Layout Rule of Asset Master Record              .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_TD_AMD_MNGR               Gets an Object for Managing Time-Dependent Data             .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Asset Data                                      .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I IS_SUBNUMBER                  Is the Asset Object a Subnumber?                            .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I PREPARE_CHANGE_DOCUMENTS      Gets All Changed Master Data of Assets for Change Docs      .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I SET_DATA                      Sets the Time-Independent Asset Master Data                 .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I SET_DESCRIPTION               Changes the Asset Name                                      .
IF_FAA_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I SET_MAIN_DESCRIPTION          Sets Name of the Main Asset Number                          .
IF_FAA_REGTAB                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization with Layout Link                             .
IF_FAA_REGTAB                  I INIT_BY_ASSET                 Initialization with Asset Link                              .
IF_FAA_REGTAB                  I IS_ACTIVE                     Is the Tab Page Active?                                     .
IF_FAA_REGTABGRP               I INIT_BY_ASSET                 Initialization                                              .
IF_FAA_REGTABGRP_BSP           I GET_MULTIGROUP_SETTING        Gets Settings for Multigroup                                .
IF_FAA_REGTABGRP_BSP           I GET_TABS                      Gets Title Element                                          .
IF_FAA_REGTAB_BSP              I GET_MULTIGROUP                Gets Multigroups of Tab Page                                .
IF_FAA_REGTAB_BSP              I GET_REGTAB_SETTING            Gets Settings for Tab Page                                  .
IF_FAA_STATIC_EVENT_HANDLER    I SET_HANDLER                   Registers the Event Handler                                 .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I ADD_CHILD                     Inserts a Subobject [final]                                 .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I CHECK_ALL                     Checks All Data [Final]                                     .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I GET_CHANGES                   Gets Original and Changed Data (for Change Documents)       .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I GET_CHILDREN                  Supplies All Subobjects Inserted with ADD_CHILD [Final]     .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I IS_MODIFIED                   Checks if data was changed [Final]                          .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I REGISTER_ALL_CHILDREN         Registers All Subobjects [Final]                            .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I SET_ACTIVITY                  Changes Processing Mode of Asset                            .
IF_FAA_STORABLE                I STORE                         Saves Changes Persistently [Final]                          .
IF_FAA_TD_AMD_MNGR             I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_FAA_TD_AMD_MNGR             I DELETE_TMINTRVL               Deletes a Time Interval                                     .
IF_FAA_TD_AMD_MNGR             I GET_TMINTRVL                  Gets the Time Interval of the Value Date                    .
IF_FAA_TD_AMD_MNGR             I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_FAA_TD_AMD_MNGR             I SET_TMINTRVL                  Adds to or Changes a Time Interval                          .
IF_FAA_VALUE_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initialization of Asset Values                              .
IF_FAA_VALUE_MNGR              I SET_AREA_VALUES               Adopt Values and Expired Useful Life                        .
IF_FAGL_ACCOUNT_DB             I DELETE                        Delete Account                                              .
IF_FAGL_ACCOUNT_DB             I GET                           Deliver All Data to Accounts from Selection                 .
IF_FAGL_ACCOUNT_DB             I INSERT                        Create Account                                              .
IF_FAGL_ACCOUNT_DB             I QUERY                         Select G/L accounts                                         .
IF_FAGL_ACCOUNT_DB             I UPDATE                        Change Account                                              .
IF_FBP_CMPERS_CONVERT          I CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT            Conversion: External to Internal                            .
IF_FBP_CMPERS_CONVERT          I CONVERT_INT_TO_EXT            Conversion: Internal to External                            .
IF_FBP_CMPERS_RESOLVE          I GET_RESOLVED_DATA             Breakdown of Intervals and Groups                           .
IF_FBRC_COMMSUPPORT            I CREATE_DEFAULT_TEXT_NO_TEMPL  Create a default text in case no template is used           .
IF_FBRC_COMMSUPPORT            I FILTER_CONTACT_PERSONS        Filter the list of contact persons available.               .
IF_FBRC_COMMSUPPORT            I POPULATE_PLACEHOLDERS         Populate the place holders in template text.                .
IF_FBRC_COMMSUPPORT            I VALUE_HELP_ALL_DBCAT          Select one database category out of all possible categories .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I CHECK_DUMMY_TOTALS_ENTRY      Check whether Totals entry is dummy or not?                 .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I DETERMINE_LED_COLOR           Determine LED Color for Tree Navigation Nodes               .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I GET_ASSIGNED_AMOUNT_FIELDS    Get Currency Key and Amount for Difference in Assigned Rec. .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I GET_DISP_DESCRIPTION          Get Descriptions for Unassigned ALV Grids                   .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I GET_LINE_ITEMS                Select Line Items for the Selected Tree Node or Set Values  .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I GET_MAPPING_TABLE             Get Mapping Table                                           .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I HANDLE_DDOWN_MENU             Add Functions to A Drop Down Menu                           .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I MANAGE_UI_FUNCTIONS           Manage UI Functions in Toolbars                             .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I PROCESS_UI_FUNCTION           Processing for Selected Function                            .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I SAVE_CHANGED_RECORDS          Save Changes                                                .
IF_FBRC_PRESENTATION           I UPDATE_STATUS_FIELD           Update status field                                         .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_DEL_SMODISRC               Delete SMODISRC with relid and smodisrc_key                 .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_GET_CV_SMODISRC            Read SMODISRC RELID = cv or tm   (Differences)              .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_GET_MERGED_SMODISRC        Merge sv + cv                                               .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_GET_SN_SMODISRC            Read SMODISRC RELID = sv (Original)                         .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_GET_SV_SMODISRC            Read SMODISRC RELID = sv (Original)                         .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_GET_VERSION_FUNC           Get Version from Repository or Vers-DB                      .
IF_FB_VA                       I IF_SAVE_SV_SMODISRC           SAVE  SMODISRC RELID = sv (Original)                        .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I CONV_EXT_TO_INT               Conversion from External to Internal Format                 .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I CONV_INT_TO_EXT               Conversion of External Representation to Interal Rep.       .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I GET_ICON                      Icon for an Object                                          .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I INITIALIZE                    Clear                                                       .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I LOAD_BEFORE_QUERY             Reload Nodes Before Search                                  .
IF_FCOM_SMP_APPL               I LOAD_SUBNODES                 Reload Subnodes                                             .
IF_FDT_ACTION                  I GET_FOLLOWUP_ACTIONS          Get the follow-up actions                                   .
IF_FDT_ACTION                  I SET_FOLLOWUP_ACTIONS          Set the follow-up actions                                   .
IF_FDT_ACTN_DYNPRO_MESSAGE     I GET_T100_MESSAGE              Get the message                                             .
IF_FDT_ACTN_DYNPRO_MESSAGE     I SET_T100_MESSAGE              Set the message                                             .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I GET_APPLICATION_LOG_OBJECT    Get the application log object                              .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I GET_MESSAGES                  Get messages to be logged                                   .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I GET_PERSISTENCY_SETTINGS      Get settings for the persistency of the logged messages     .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I SET_APPLICATION_LOG_OBJECT    Set the application log object                              .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I SET_MESSAGES                  Set messages to be logged                                   .
IF_FDT_ACTN_MESSAGE_LOG        I SET_PERSISTENCY_SETTINGS      Set settings for the persistency of the logged messages     .
IF_FDT_ACTN_STATIC_METHOD      I GET_CLASS                     Get the class (implementing IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD_TEMPLATE)  .
IF_FDT_ACTN_STATIC_METHOD      I GET_SUB_EXPRESSIONS           Get sub expressions                                         .
IF_FDT_ACTN_STATIC_METHOD      I SET_CLASS                     Set the class (implementing IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD_TEMPLATE)  .
IF_FDT_ACTN_STATIC_METHOD      I SET_SUB_EXPRESSIONS           Set sub expressions                                         .
IF_FDT_ACTN_WORKFLOW           I GET_WORKFLOW                  Get single workflow definition                              .
IF_FDT_ACTN_WORKFLOW           I GET_WORKFLOW_TABLE            Get a table with several workflows                          .
IF_FDT_ACTN_WORKFLOW           I REMOVE_WORKFLOW               Remove single workflow definition                           .
IF_FDT_ACTN_WORKFLOW           I SET_WORKFLOW                  Set single workflow definition                              .
IF_FDT_ACTN_WORKFLOW           I SET_WORKFLOW_TABLE            Set a table with several workflows                          .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_ACCESS_LEVEL              Get Access Level                                            .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_ACTIVE_VERSION            Get the Active Version (optional for a timestamp)           .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_APPLICATION               Get the Application                                         .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_CHANGE_INFO               Information about Last Change (user and timestamp)          .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_DOCUMENTATION             Get the Documentation                                       .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_NAME                      Get the Name (non-unique)                                   .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Get the Object Type (see constants in IF_FDT_CONSTANTS)     .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_REFERENCED_OBJECTS        Get all Referenced Objects                                  .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_TEXTS                     Get the Texts                                               .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_VERSIONS                  Get a List of Versions                                      .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I GET_WHERE_USED                Get Usages of Object                                        .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I SET_ACCESS_LEVEL              Set Access Level                                            .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I SET_APPLICATION               Set the Application                                         .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I SET_DOCUMENTATION             Set the Documentation                                       .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I SET_NAME                      Set the Name (non-unique)                                   .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I SET_TEXTS                     Set the Texts                                               .
IF_FDT_ADMIN_DATA              I TO_STRING                     A String Description of the Customizing                     .
IF_FDT_AND_OR                  I GET_OPERATION                 Get the operation                                           .
IF_FDT_AND_OR                  I GET_PARAMETERS                Get AND/OR parameter table                                  .
IF_FDT_AND_OR                  I SET_OPERATION                 Set the operation                                           .
IF_FDT_AND_OR                  I SET_PARAMETERS                Set AND/OR parameter table                                  .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I CREATE_SYSTEM_APPLICATION     Create a System Application                                 .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION_COMPONENT     Get the Application Component                               .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I GET_SETTINGS_CLASS            Get the Settings Class and Interface                        .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I GET_SOFTWARE_COMPONENT        Get the Software Component                                  .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I SET_APPLICATION_COMPONENT     Set the Application Component                               .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I SET_SETTINGS_CLASS            Set the Settings Class and Interface                        .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I SET_SOFTWARE_COMPONENT        Set the Software Component                                  .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION             I TRANSPORT_INCL_ASSIGNED_OBJECTTransport the application and all objects assigned to it    .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION_SETTINGS    I ACTIVATION_VETO               Possibility to Veto the Activation of an Object             .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION_SETTINGS    I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Perform an Authority Check (AUTHORITY-CHECK)                .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION_SETTINGS    I GET_CALENDAR                  Get Calendar for Date & Time Functions                      .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION_SETTINGS    I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Get the Timestamp                                           .
IF_FDT_APPLICATION_SETTINGS    I SAVE_NOTIFICATION             Notify when an object is saved                              .
IF_FDT_BOOLEAN                 I GET_OPERANDS                  Get the operands for the operation                          .
IF_FDT_BOOLEAN                 I GET_OPERATION                 Get the operation                                           .
IF_FDT_BOOLEAN                 I SET_OPERANDS                  Set the operands for the operation                          .
IF_FDT_BOOLEAN                 I SET_OPERATION                 Set the operation                                           .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I GET_CASE_PARAMETER            Gets the case value for the Expression Type                 .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I GET_CASE_SENSITIVITY          Gets information about case sensitivity in comparisons      .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I GET_OTHER_PARAMETER           Gets the "Others" value for the Expression Type             .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I GET_WHEN_TABLE                Gets the "When" table for the Expression Type               .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I SET_CASE_PARAMETER            Sets the case value for the Expression Type                 .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I SET_CASE_SENSITIVITY          Sets information about case sensitivity in comparisons      .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I SET_OTHER_PARAMETER           Sets the "Others" value for the Expression Type             .
IF_FDT_CASE                    I SET_WHEN_TABLE                Sets the "When" table for the Expression Type               .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I CREATE_NODE                   Create a new tree node                                      .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I DELETE_NODE                   Delete a node including all his children                    .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I GET_CATALOG_PROPERTIES        Get properties of the catalog                               .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I GET_CATALOG_STRUCTURE         Get (sub-)catalog structure                                 .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I GET_CHILDREN                  Get the children below a given node                         .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I GET_NODE_PROPERTIES           Get properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I MOVE_NODE                     Relocate an existing node (with subnodes) within the tree   .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I SET_CATALOG_PROPERTIES        Set properties of the catalog                               .
IF_FDT_CATALOG                 I SET_NODE_PROPERTIES           Set properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_CC_ANNOTATION           I GET_CONTEXT                   Supplies Context                                            .
IF_FDT_CC_ANNOTATION           I GET_NAME                      Supplies Name                                               .
IF_FDT_CC_ANNOTATION           I GET_TYPE                      Supplies Type                                               .
IF_FDT_CC_ANNOTATION           I GET_VALUE                     Supplies Value                                              .
IF_FDT_CC_REPEAT               I ADD_VAR                       Add Variable                                                .
IF_FDT_CC_REPEAT               I CREATE_REPEAT                 Initialize New Repeat Block                                 .
IF_FDT_CC_REPEAT               I NEXT                          Initialize Next Run                                         .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I FIND_SLOT                     Searches for a Contained Slot                               .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I GET_CODE                      Supplies the Code                                           .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I GET_FIRST_LINE_NUMBER         Supplies the Line Number of Start (if Embedded)             .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I GET_LAST_LINE_NUMBER          Supplies the Line Number of End (if Embedded)               .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I GET_NAME                      Supplies the Name                                           .
IF_FDT_CC_SLOT                 I SET_CODE                      Sets the Code                                               .
IF_FDT_CHANGE_MGMT             I IS_AUTO_ADJUSTED              Object was automatically readjusted to change of used object.
IF_FDT_CONSTANT                I GET_CONSTANT_VALUE            Get the Constant Value                                      .
IF_FDT_CONSTANT                I SET_CONSTANT_VALUE            Set the Constant Value                                      .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I COPY                          Copy the Context                                            .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I GET_DATA_OBJECTS              Get all Data Objects                                        .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Get an instance                                             .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I GET_VALUE                     Get a Value for a Data Object                               .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I INSERT_DATA_OBJECT            Insert a Data Object                                        .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I REMOVE_DATA_OBJECT            Remove a Data Object                                        .
IF_FDT_CONTEXT                 I SET_VALUE                     Set a Value for a Data Object                               .
IF_FDT_DATA_EXCHANGE           I EXPORT_XML                    Export XML                                                  .
IF_FDT_DATA_EXCHANGE           I EXPORT_XML_APPLICATION        Export XML for an Application incl. all Objects             .
IF_FDT_DATA_EXCHANGE           I IMPORT_XML                    Import XML                                                  .
IF_FDT_DATA_EXCHANGE_INTERNAL  I EXPORT_XML                    Export to XML                                               .
IF_FDT_DATA_EXCHANGE_INTERNAL  I IMPORT_XML                    Import from XML                                             .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I CONVERT_TO                    Converts data according to the supplied object              .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Create and return a data reference for the data object      .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I DERIVE_DATA_OBJECT            Derive FDT data object description                          .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_BINDING_TYPE              Get the binding type                                        .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_DATA_OBJECT_TYPE          Get the data object type                                    .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_DDIC_BINDING              Get DDIC binding                                            .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I IS_CONVERTIBLE_TO             Checks the convertibility to the supplied object            .
IF_FDT_DATA_OBJECT             I SET_DDIC_BINDING              Set DDIC binding                                            .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I GET_COLUMNS                   Get the columns of the decision table                       .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I GET_TABLE_DATA                Get all data content of the decision table                  .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I GET_TABLE_PROPERTY            Get general properties of the decision table                .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I SET_COLUMNS                   Set the columns of the decision table and their order       .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I SET_TABLE_DATA                Set data content of the decision table, all data at once    .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TABLE          I SET_TABLE_PROPERTY            Set general properties of the decision table                .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TREE           I GET_CHILDREN                  Get the 2 children of a condition node                      .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TREE           I GET_NODE_PROPERTY             Get properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TREE           I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Get the root node of the tree                               .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TREE           I GET_TREE_STRUCTURE            Get (sub-)tree structure                                    .
IF_FDT_DECISION_TREE           I SET_NODE_PROPERTY             Set properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_DYNAMIC_EXPRESSION      I GET_MODE                      Get mode                                                    .
IF_FDT_DYNAMIC_EXPRESSION      I GET_PARAMETER                 Get the parameter ID for the expression ID                  .
IF_FDT_DYNAMIC_EXPRESSION      I SET_MODE                      Set mode                                                    .
IF_FDT_DYNAMIC_EXPRESSION      I SET_PARAMETER                 Set the parameter ID for the expression ID                  .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I GET_ALLOWED_COMPARISONS       Get information about allowed comparisons                   .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I GET_ELEMENT_TYPE              Get FDT element type                                        .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I GET_REFERENCED_ELEMENT        Get the ID of the referenced element                        .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I SET_ALLOWED_COMPARISONS       Set information about allowed comparisons                   .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I SET_ELEMENT_TYPE              Set FDT element type                                        .
IF_FDT_ELEMENT                 I SET_REFERENCED_ELEMENT        Set the ID of the referenced element                        .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I GENERATE_PROCESS              Generate source code for method PROCESS                     .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I GET_CONTEXT_DATA_OBJECTS      Get context data objects                                    .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I GET_EXPRESSION_TYPE           Get the expression type                                     .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I GET_RESULT_DATA_OBJECT        Get result data object                                      .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I GET_USED_EXPRESSIONS          Get used expressions                                        .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I PROCESS                       Process                                                     .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I SET_CONTEXT_DATA_OBJECTS      Set context data objects                                    .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION              I SET_RESULT_DATA_OBJECT        Set result data object                                      .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I GET_ACTION_PROPERTIES         Get action properties                                       .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I GET_EXPRESSION_CLASS          Get expression class and interface                          .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I GET_EXPRESSION_TEXTS          Get the expression's maintenance texts                      .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I GET_QUERY_CLASS               Get query class                                             .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I SET_ACTION_PROPERTIES         Set action properties                                       .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I SET_EXPRESSION_CLASS          Set expression class and interface                          .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I SET_EXPRESSION_TEXTS          Set the expression's maintenance texts                      .
IF_FDT_EXPRESSION_TYPE         I SET_QUERY_CLASS               Set query class                                             .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_APPLICATION               Get an application instance                                 .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_CATALOG                   Get the catalog instance                                    .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_DATA_EXCHANGE             Get the data exchange instance                              .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_DATA_OBJECT               Get a data object instance                                  .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_EXPRESSION                Get an expression instance                                  .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_EXPRESSION_TYPE           Get an expression type instance                             .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_FILTER                    Get a filter instance                                       .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_FUNCTION                  Get a function instance                                     .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Get a factory instance                                      .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_QUERY                     Get the query instance                                      .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_RULESET                   Get a ruleset instance                                      .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_TRACE                     Get the trace instance                                      .
IF_FDT_FACTORY                 I GET_WORKLIST                  Get the worklist instance                                   .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I APPLY_FILTER                  Apply filter to an object                                   .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I CLEAR_INCLUDED_FILTERS        Remove all included filters                                 .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I CLEAR_OBJECTS                 Remove all objects                                          .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I EXCLUDE_FILTER                Exclude a filter                                            .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I GET_INCLUDED_FILTERS          Get the included filters                                    .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I GET_OBJECTS                   Get the objects                                             .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I GET_TYPE                      Get the type of the filter                                  .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I INCLUDE_FILTER                Include a filter                                            .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I INSERT_OBJECT                 Insert an object                                            .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I REMOVE_OBJECT                 Remove an object                                            .
IF_FDT_FILTER                  I SET_TYPE                      Set the type of the filter                                  .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_CONTEXT_CLASS             Get the context class (context impl. by application)        .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_CONTEXT_DATA_OBJECTS      Get context data objects                                    .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_EXPRESSION                Get the assigned expression                                 .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_FILTER                    Get a set filter                                            .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_FUNCTION_MODE             Get the function mode                                       .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_PROCESS_CONTEXT           Get the context for the process                             .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_RESULT_DATA_OBJECT        Get result data object                                      .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I GET_TRACE_MODE                Get the trace mode                                          .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I PROCESS                       Process                                                     .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_CONTEXT_CLASS             Set the context class (context impl. by application)        .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_CONTEXT_DATA_OBJECTS      Set context data objects                                    .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_EXPRESSION                Set the assigned expression                                 .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_FILTER                    Set a filter                                                .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_FUNCTION_MODE             Set the function mode                                       .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_RESULT_DATA_OBJECT        Set result data object                                      .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION                I SET_TRACE_MODE                Set the trace mode                                          .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION_CALL           I GET_FUNCTION                  Get the FDT function                                        .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION_CALL           I GET_MAPPING                   Get the mapping                                             .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION_CALL           I SET_FUNCTION                  Set the FDT function                                        .
IF_FDT_FUNCTION_CALL           I SET_MAPPING                   Set the mapping                                             .
IF_FDT_OBJECT_QUERY            I CLOSE_CURSOR                  Close Cursor                                                .
IF_FDT_OBJECT_QUERY            I FETCH_DATA                    Fetch Data Package for the Cursor Selection                 .
IF_FDT_OBJECT_QUERY            I GET_FIELD_LIST                Field Information                                           .
IF_FDT_OBJECT_QUERY            I PREPARE_SELECT                Prepare Cursor Selection (set Metadata)                     .
IF_FDT_OBJECT_QUERY            I SELECT_DATA                   Selection                                                   .
IF_FDT_PROCESSOR               I PROCESS                       Processes an expression                                     .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I GET_FIELD_LIST                NEW: Published Constants for all available Queryfields      .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I GET_IDS                       Get the IDs for a semantic key                              .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I GET_NAME                      Get the name for an ID                                      .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Get the object type for an ID                               .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_APPLICATIONS            OBSOLETE: Query for applications                            .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_DATA_OBJECTS            OBSOLETE: Query data objects                                .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_ELEMENTS                OBSOLETE: Query elements                                    .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_EXPRESSIONS             OBSOLETE: Query expressions                                 .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_EXPRESSION_TYPES        OBSOLETE: Query expression types                            .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_FILTERS                 OBSOLETE: Query filters                                     .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_FUNCTIONS               OBSOLETE: Query functions                                   .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I QUERY_OBJECTS                 OBSOLETE: Query across FDT objects                          .
IF_FDT_QUERY                   I SELECT_DATA                   NEW: Dynamical Selection of Data                            .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I GET_BORDERS                   Get the borders (min, max)                                  .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I GET_DECIMALS                  Get the number of decimals                                  .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I GET_PROBABILITY               Get the probabilty in case of boolean result                .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I SET_BORDERS                   Set the borders (min, max)                                  .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I SET_DECIMALS                  Set the number of decimals                                  .
IF_FDT_RANDOM                  I SET_PROBABILITY               Set the probability in case of boolean result               .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I COMPARE_TO_RANGE              Compare with another range with the same test parameter     .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I GET_CASE_SENSITIVITY          Gets information about case sensitivity in comparisons      .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I GET_RANGE                     Gets the range for the expression Type                      .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I GET_TEST_PARAMETER            Gets the test parameter for the range                       .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I SET_CASE_SENSITIVITY          Sets information about case sensitivity in comparisons      .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I SET_RANGE                     Sets the range for the Expression Type                      .
IF_FDT_RANGE                   I SET_TEST_PARAMETER            Sets the test parameter for the range                       .
IF_FDT_RESULT                  I COPY                          Copy the result                                             .
IF_FDT_RESULT                  I GET_DATA_OBJECT               Get the data object                                         .
IF_FDT_RESULT                  I GET_VALUE                     Get the value for the data object                           .
IF_FDT_RESULT                  I SET_DATA_OBJECT               Set the data object                                         .
IF_FDT_RESULT                  I SET_VALUE                     Set the value for the data object                           .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I CLEAR                         Clear parameter                                             .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I GET_CONDITION                 Get the condition                                           .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I GET_FALSE_ACTION              Get the action for the condition being false                .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I GET_TRUE_ACTION               Get the action for the condition being true                 .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I SET_CONDITION                 Set the condition                                           .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I SET_FALSE_ACTION              Set the action for the condition being false                .
IF_FDT_RULE                    I SET_TRUE_ACTION               Set the action for the condition being true                 .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I ADD_RULE                      Add rule(s)                                                 .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I DELETE_RULE                   Delete rule(s)                                              .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I GET_FUNCTION_RESTRICTION      Get the function restriction                                .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I GET_RULES                     Get rules                                                   .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I GET_RULESET_CONDITION         Get the condition for the complete rule set                 .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I SET_FUNCTION_RESTRICTION      Set the function restriction                                .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I SET_RULES                     Set rules                                                   .
IF_FDT_RULESET                 I SET_RULESET_CONDITION         Set the condition for the complete rule set                 .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I CREATE_NODE                   Create a new tree node                                      .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I DELETE_NODE                   Delete a node including all his children                    .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I GET_CHILDREN                  Get the children below a given node                         .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I GET_NODE_PROPERTY             Get properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Get the root node of the tree                               .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I GET_TREE_PROPERTY             Get properties of the tree                                  .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I GET_TREE_STRUCTURE            Get (sub-)tree structure                                    .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I MOVE_NODE                     Relocate an existing node (with subnodes) within the tree   .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I SET_NODE_PROPERTY             Set properties of a node                                    .
IF_FDT_SEARCH_TREE             I SET_TREE_PROPERTY             Set properties of the tree                                  .
IF_FDT_SIMPLE_VALUE_REQUEST    I GET_DISPATCHER                Get dispatcher expression                                   .
IF_FDT_SIMPLE_VALUE_REQUEST    I GET_SIMPLE_VALUE              Get parameter of simple value request                       .
IF_FDT_SIMPLE_VALUE_REQUEST    I SET_DISPATCHER                Set dispatcher expression                                   .
IF_FDT_SIMPLE_VALUE_REQUEST    I SET_SIMPLE_VALUE              Set parameter of simple value request                       .
IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD           I GET_CLASS                     Get the class (implementing IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD_TEMPLATE)  .
IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD           I GET_SUB_EXPRESSIONS           Get sub expressions                                         .
IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD           I SET_CLASS                     Set the class (implementing IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD_TEMPLATE)  .
IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD           I SET_SUB_EXPRESSIONS           Set sub expressions                                         .
IF_FDT_STATIC_METHOD_TEMPLATE  I PROCESS                       Process                                                     .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I DELETE                        Delete a table                                              .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I DELETE_GENERIC                Delete generically                                          .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I DELETE_SINGLE                 Delete a structure                                          .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Get an instance                                             .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I QUERY                         Query across FDT objects                                    .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I READ                          Read into table                                             .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I READ_SINGLE                   Read into structure                                         .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I SPLIT_TABLE                   Compare 2 tables and split into write and delete            .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I WRITE                         Write a table                                               .
IF_FDT_STORAGE                 I WRITE_SINGLE                  Write a structure                                           .
IF_FDT_STRUCTURE               I GET_ELEMENTS                  Get elements                                                .
IF_FDT_STRUCTURE               I SET_ELEMENTS                  Set elements                                                .
IF_FDT_TABLE                   I GET_STRUCTURE                 Get the tables structure                                    .
IF_FDT_TABLE                   I SET_STRUCTURE                 Set the tables structure                                    .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I GET_DISPATCHER                Get dispatcher expression                                   .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I GET_TABLE_REQUEST             Get parameter of table request                              .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I GET_WHERE_TABLE               Get the "Where" table for the expression type               .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I SET_DISPATCHER                Set dispatcher expression                                   .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I SET_TABLE_REQUEST             Set parameter of table request                              .
IF_FDT_TABLE_REQUEST           I SET_WHERE_TABLE               Set the "Where" table for the expression type               .
IF_FDT_TRACE                   I DELETE                        Delete traced data                                          .
IF_FDT_TRACE                   I READ                          Read traced data                                            .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_CONTEXT_DATA              Log information for context data                            .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_EXCEPTION                 Log an exception                                            .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_EXPRESSION_END            Log the expression processing end                           .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_EXPRESSION_START          Log the expression processing start                         .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_FUNCTION_END              Log the function processing end                             .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_FUNCTION_START            Log the function processing start                           .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_RESULT_DATA               Log information for the result data                         .
IF_FDT_TRACE_WRITE             I LOG_TEXT                      Log free text                                               .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I ACTIVATE                      Activate the object (needs a subsequent save!)              .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Perform an authority check (AUTHORITY-CHECK)                .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I CHECK                         Check the object                                            .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I COPY                          Return a copy of the object                                 .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I DELETE                        Delete the object (the complete instance with all versions) .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I DEQUEUE                       Dequeue the object                                          .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I DISCARD_CHANGES               Discard unsaved changes                                     .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I ENQUEUE                       Enqueue the object                                          .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I SAVE                          Save the object                                             .
IF_FDT_TRANSACTION             I TRANSPORT                     Collect and return transport information                    .
IF_FDT_VALUE_REQU_DISPATCHER   I DERIVE_RESULT_DO_TABLE        Get data object table for ddic-object                       .
IF_FDT_VALUE_REQU_DISPATCHER   I GET_DISPATCHER_TABLE          Gets the "Dispatcher" table for the Expression Type         .
IF_FDT_VALUE_REQU_DISPATCHER   I SET_DISPATCHER_TABLE          Gets the "Dispatcher" table for the Expression Type         .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I DETECT_MASS_SEQUENCE          Detect the sequence for the mass operations                 .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I GET_INACTIVE_OBJECTS          Get inactive objects                                        .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I GET_OBJECTS_TO_GENERATE       Get objects that need to be generated                       .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I GET_UNSAVED_OBJECTS           Get unsaved objects                                         .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_ACTIVATION               Mass Activation of Objects                                  .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_CHECK                    Mass Check of Objects                                       .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_DELETION                 Mass Deletion of Objects                                    .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_DEQUEUE                  Mass Dequeue of Objects                                     .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_ENQUEUE                  Mass Enqueue of Objects                                     .
IF_FDT_WORKLIST                I MASS_SAVE                     Mass Save of Objects                                        .
IF_FDT_XSL_TRANSFORMATION      I GET_TRANSFORMATION            Get transformation program                                  .
IF_FDT_XSL_TRANSFORMATION      I SET_TRANSFORMATION            Set transformation program                                  .
IF_FEBAN_SELECTION             I CLEARUP                       Necessary Clearing-up Work when the Implementation Changes  .
IF_FEBAN_SELECTION             I DISPLAY                       Displays Selection in Control                               .
IF_FIELDSELECTION_MM           I FS_GET                        Get Field Selection                                         .
IF_FILL_LE_INDX                I FILL_VTRDI_INDX               Complete Additional Fields Delivery Index Transport         .
IF_FILTER_CHECK_AND_F4         I CHECK                         Value Check                                                 .
IF_FILTER_CHECK_AND_F4         I F4                            Input Help                                                  .
IF_FILTER_CHECK_AND_F4         I INIT                          Initialization of Instance                                  .
IF_FILTER_CHECK_AND_F4         I SHOW_F4_ICON                  Display Input Help Icon?                                    .
IF_FILTER_VALUE_FOR_COCO       I GET_FILTER_FOR_COCO           Filter Value to Display in Control Composite                .
IF_FIMA_CALLBACK               I AMOUNTCOMP_DETERMINE          Calulate Amount to be Capitalized                           .
IF_FIMA_CALLBACK_RATES         I INTERESTRATES_GET             Read Interest Reference Rate Values                         .
IF_FIMA_ITERATION_OBJECT       I CALCULATE_ITERATION_STEP      Calculates an Iteration Step                                .
IF_FINB_ACCSYS_VALUATION_RULE  I GET_CURRENCY_KEY              Gets Currency Key for Reference Currency ID                 .
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_ACSYST_IDS_BY_CHARACTERS  Provides the valuation systs for chr. vals to be indentified.
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_ACTIVE_CURTYPES_OF_ACSYST Provides the Active Currency Types in a Valuation System    .
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_ALL_ACTIVE_ACSYST         Provides all Valuation Systems in an Accounting Instance    .
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_DESCRIPTION_OF_ACSYST     Provides the Descriptive Characteristics of a Valuation Sys..
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_DETERMINING_CHARACTERCS   Provides the Identifying Characteristics of All Val. Systems.
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_FACADE      I GET_STATUS_OF_ACINST          Provides the Status of a Valuation System                   .
IF_FINB_ACC_SYSTEM_HOME        I GET_ACCOUNTING_SYSTEM_FACADE  Provides the Instance of the Factory                        .
IF_FINB_ACINST_CLEAN_UP_PARTLY I CHECK_AND_DELETE              Deletes Partial Aspects of an Accounting Instance           .
IF_FINB_COMPLEX_CONTXT_FACTORY I ADD_CONTEXT                   Adds Context to Context Object                              .
IF_FINB_COMPLEX_CONTXT_FACTORY I GET_CONTEXT                   Fetches Entire Context of a Context Object                  .
IF_FINB_COMPLEX_MSG_CONTEXT    I ADD_CONTEXT                   Public                                                      .
IF_FINB_COMPLEX_MSG_CONTEXT    I GET_CONTEXT                   Public                                                      .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_CALLBACK I ACTIVATE                      Activates Component                                         .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_CALLBACK I USED_COMPONENT_ACTIVATION     Components used should be activated                         .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I GET_CONFIGURATION_TREE        Pick Configuration                                          .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I READ_CONFIG_VIA_ABAP          Pick Configuration in Table Form                            .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I READ_CONFIG_VIA_XPATH         Pick Configuration via xpach in Table Form                  .
IF_FINB_CONFIGURATION_SERVICE  I SET_CONFIGURATION             Maintain configuration                                      .
IF_FINB_CONFIG_DEPLOYMENT_READ I READ_CONFIG_LAST_CHANGE       Pick Change Info of Configuration                           .
IF_FINB_CONFIG_DEPLOYMENT_READ I READ_CONFIG_VIA_ABAP          Pick Configuration in Table Form                            .
IF_FINB_CONFIG_DEPLOYMENT_READ I READ_CONFIG_VIA_XPATH         Pick Configuration via xpach in Table Form                  .
IF_FINB_CONFIG_MAINTAIN        I READ_LOCAL_CONTENT_FOR_UPDATE Pick Configuration in Table Form                            .
IF_FINB_CUST_CHANGE_DISPATCHER I RECEIVE_CHANGED_CONFIG_KEY    Accept Changed Configuration Key                            .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I ACTIVATE_CONFIGURATION        Activate Configuration                                      .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I DELETE                        Delete Configuration                                        .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I GET_COMMSTRUCTURE             Fetch Communication Structure                               .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I GET_GENERATED_OBJS            Provides Generated Objects                                  .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I SET_CONFIGURATION             Set Configuration                                           .
IF_FINB_DMT_CONFIGURATOR       I SET_INDEX                     Create Index                                                .
IF_FINB_DMT_PERSISTOR          I ADD_DATA                      Adds Key Figures                                            .
IF_FINB_DMT_PERSISTOR          I DELETE_DATA                   Deletes Totals Record                                       .
IF_FINB_DMT_PERSISTOR          I REFRESH                       Deletes Reconstructable Data                                .
IF_FINB_DMT_PERSISTOR          I SET_DATA                      Sets Key Figures                                            .
IF_FINB_DMT_PERSISTOR          I SUB_DATA                      Subtracts Key Figures                                       .
IF_FINB_FOBJ_JOIN_READER       I OPEN_CURSOR                   Open Cursor                                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_AFTER_CONVERSION    I AFTER_CNV_HANDLER             Tool for Post-Processing Conversion                         .
IF_FINB_GN_BUILDING_PLAN       I CREATE_BUILDING_PLAN          Instatiates a Blueprint                                     .
IF_FINB_GN_BUILDING_PLAN       I EXECUTION                     Generates Raw Objects                                       .
IF_FINB_GN_BUILDING_PLAN       I GET_CONFIG_OBJ                Provides Configuration Object                               .
IF_FINB_GN_BUILDING_PLAN       I GET_CONFIG_TIME_STAMP         Last Change to the Configuration Object                     .
IF_FINB_GN_BUILDING_PLAN       I INCREASE_ENQ_CNT              Increases/Decreases Lock Counter                            .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_ACT_PROT_PREFIX           Provides Prefix for Activation Log                          .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_CLIENT_HANDLING           Provides Client Handling                                    .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_DEFAULT_PACKAGE           Provides Package for Generated Objects                      .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_MODUS                     Provides Generator Mode                                     .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_NAMESPACE                 Provides Name Prefix                                        .
IF_FINB_GN_CONFIGURATION       I GET_TRANSPORT_HANDLING        Provides Transport Handling of the Object Name              .
IF_FINB_GN_DTEL                I GET_TEXTS                     Provides the Texts                                          .
IF_FINB_GN_DTEL                I GET_TYPE                      Provides Type Description for the Data Element              .
IF_FINB_GN_ERR_OBJECT          I GET_ERROR_DESCRIPTION         Provides Description of Error                               .
IF_FINB_GN_FIELD               I GET_FIELD_TYPE                Gets Field Type (Field Type Must Exist Locally)             .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I ACTIVATE_OBJECTS              Activates/Deletes the Objects                               .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CHECK_AND_GENERATE            Checks Objects and Generates Raw Objects                    .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CHECK_AND_WAIT                Check and - if necessary - wait for activation              .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CHECK_CRIT_CHANGES            Checks for Critical Changes                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CHECK_OBJECTS                 Checks the Saved Objects                                    .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CLEAR_WORKLIST                Deletes Processed Worklist                                  .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I CONVERT_TABLES                Table Conversion                                            .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I DELETE_OBJECTS                Marks the Objects in a Plant for Deletion                   .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_BUILDING_PLAN_OBJECTS     Provides Generated Objects in a Blueprint                   .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_CONFIGURATION             Provide Generator Configuration                             .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_GENERATED_OBJECT          Provides Information for a Generated Object                 .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_LANGUAGES_OBJECTS         Provides Language Subobjects for the Objects in a Blueprint .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_OBJECT_FACTORY            Provides a Plant for Processing                             .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_PHYSICAL_NAME             Provides Physical Name of an Active Object                  .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_SINGLE_LANGUAGES_OBJECT   Provides Language Suboejct for a Logical Object             .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I GET_WORKLIST_OBJECTS          Provides Saved/Activated Objects from the Worklist          .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I LOW_TO_HIGH_LEVEL_OBJ         Converts a Low-Level Object into a High-Level Object        .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I PREPARE_SAVE_OBJECTS          Preparation for Saving                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I SAVE_OBJECTS                  Saves the Created Raw Objects                               .
IF_FINB_GN_HIGH_LEVEL          I SET_AFTER_CNV_HANDLER         Sets Post-Processing Tool for Conversion                    .
IF_FINB_GN_LANGUAGES           I SET_BUSINESS_NAME             Sets the Business Name (Optional)                           .
IF_FINB_GN_LANGUAGES_DTEL      I GET_TEXTS                     Provides the Texts                                          .
IF_FINB_GN_LANGUAGES_DTEL      I SET_META_DESCRIPT             Sets Meta Description for the Object                        .
IF_FINB_GN_LANGUAGES_DTEL      I SET_TEXTS                     Sets the Texts (Optional)                                   .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I ACTIVATE_WORKLIST             Activates/Deletes the Objects from the Worklist             .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I ADD_ANY_OBJECT                Adds Any Object to the Worklist for Checking/Activation     .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CHECK_AND_WAIT                Check and - if necessary - wait for activation              .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CHECK_CRIT_CHANGES            Checks for Critical Changes                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CHECK_WORKLIST                Checks the Objects from the Worklist                        .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CLEAN_UP_BUILDING_PLAN_OBJS   Deletes objects that were not newly generated in a blueprint.
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CLEAR_WORKLIST                Deletes Processed Worklist                                  .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CONVERT_TABLES                Table Conversion                                            .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I CREATE_RAW_OBJECT             Adds a New Raw Object to the Worklist                       .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I DELETE_ALL_OBJS               Deletes All Objects for an Application in a Client          .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I DELETE_OBJECT                 Adds an Object To Be Deleted to the Worklist                .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I DELETE_VERSIONS               Deletes Old Versions of a High-Level Object                 .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_BUILDING_PLAN_OBJS        Provides all existing objects in a blueprint                .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_CONFIGURATION             Provide Generator Configuration                             .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_GENERATED_OBJECT          Provides Information for a Generated Object                 .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_LANGUAGES_OBJECT          Provides Language Object for a Generated Object             .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_MSG_HANDLER               Gets Message Handler                                        .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_SINGLE_OBJECT             Provides the Object from the Worklist for the Logical Name  .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_VERSIONS                  Deletes All Old Versions of a High-Level Object             .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I GET_WORKLIST_OBJECTS          Provides Saved/Activated Objects from the Worklist          .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I PREPARE_SAVE_WORKLIST         Preparation for Saving                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I SAVE_WORKLIST                 Saves the Objects from the Worklist                         .
IF_FINB_GN_LOW_LEVEL           I SET_AFTER_CNV_HANDLER         Sets Post-Processing Tool for Conversion                    .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT              I CHECK_AND_WAIT                Check and - if necessary - wait for activation              .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT              I GET_BUSINESS_NAME             Provides Business Name                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT              I GET_CATALOG_ENTRY             Provides Catalog Entry                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT              I GET_CROSSREF                  Provides Where-Used List                                    .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT              I GET_PHYSICAL_NAME             Provides Physical Name of the Object                        .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT_LEVEL        I ADD_OBJECT                    Internal Use: Inserts an Object in AT_USED                  .
IF_FINB_GN_OBJECT_LEVEL        I SET_LEVEL                     Internal Use: Sets the Object Level                         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I ADD_TEXT                      Adds a Text to the Text Pool                                .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_DEPENDENCE                Sets Dependendy of other Objects                            .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_FIXPT                     Sets Fixed Point Arithmetic (Default: On)                   .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_PROG_TYPE                 Sets the Program Type (-" Domain SUBC, Default, Program)    .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_TEMPLATE                  Sets the Template Name                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_TEMPLATE_PARAM            Sets the Template Parameter (Default:  = A_BUILDING_PLAN)   .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ABAP            I SET_TEXTPOOL                  Sets the Entire Text Pool (Optional)                        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_DTEL            I SET_TEXTS                     Sets the Texts (Optional)                                   .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_DTEL            I SET_TYPE                      Sets the Type                                               .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_ENQU            I ADD_COMPONENT                 Adds Fields to the Lock Argument                            .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FIELD           I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets the Descriptive Object                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FIELD           I SET_TYPE_GROUP_ELEMENT        Name of a Type Group Element (Must Exist Locally)           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FPOOL           I ADD_TEXT                      Adds a Text to the Text Pool                                .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FPOOL           I SET_CODING_INCLUDE            Sets the Include for Forms etc. (Optional)                  .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FPOOL           I SET_GLOBAL_DATA               Sets the Include with Global Definitions (Optional)         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FPOOL           I SET_TEXTPOOL                  Sets the Entire Text Pool (Optional)                        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_CHANGING_PARAM            Inserts a Changing Parameter                                .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_EXCEPTION                 Inserts an Exception                                        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_EXPORTING_PARAM           Inserts an Export Parameter                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_IMPORTING_PARAM           Inserts an Import Parameter                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_TABLES_PARAM              Adds a Table Parameter                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I ADD_TEXT                      Adds a Text to the Text Pool                                .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I SET_POOL                      Sets the Function Group (Optional)                          .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I SET_REMOTE_FLAG               Sets the Remote Flag                                        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I SET_TEMPLATE                  Sets the Template Name                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I SET_TEMPLATE_PARAM            Sets the Template Parameter (Default:  = A_BUILDING_PLAN)   .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_FUNCTION        I SET_UP_TASK                   Sets the Process Type in Updating                           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_INDEX           I ADD_FIELD                     Adds an Index Field                                         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_INDEX           I SET_ALL_DB                    Create Index for All Database Systems (Optional)            .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_INDEX           I SET_TABLE                     Table                                                       .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_INDEX           I SET_UNIQUE                    Unique/Non-Unique Index (Optional)                          .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I ADD_TARGET_SYSTEM             System in Which the Object is to Be Generated (Optional)    .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I GET_CATALOG_ENTRY             Provides Catalog Entry                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I GET_CRIT_CHANGES              Provides Critical Changes                                   .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_BUILDING_PLAN             Generating Blueprint (Optional with Low Level SS)           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_BUSINESS_NAME             Sets the Business Name (Optional)                           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_KEEP_VERSION              Overwrite (Default) or Keep the Old Version                 .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_LOGICAL_NAME              Sets the Logical Name (Optional with Low Level SS)          .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_PACKAGE                   Sets the Package for the Generated Object (Optional)        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_PHYSICAL_NAME             Sets the Physical Name (Optional)                           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_PREFIX_2                  Sets 2nd Name Prefix for the Object (Optional)              .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_OBJECT          I SET_SYS_UPGRADE               Behaviour of the Object at System Upgrage (Optional)        .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_STRUC           I ADD_COMPONENT                 Inserts a Component                                         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_STRUC           I CLIENT_SPECIFIC               Sets Client Dependence                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_TABLE           I INIT_NEW_FIELDS               Initialization of Added Fields During Activation            .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_TABLE           I SET_TECH_SETTINGS             Sets the Technical Settings                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_TTYP            I ADD_KEY_FIELD                 Adds a Field to the Key (Optional)                          .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_TTYP            I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets the Attributes                                         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_TTYP            I SET_LINE_TYPE                 Sets the Row Type                                           .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_VIEW            I ADD_COMPONENT                 Inserts a Component                                         .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_VIEW            I ADD_JOIN_CONDITION            Adds a Join Condition                                       .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_VIEW            I ADD_SEL_CONDITION             Adds a Selection Condition                                  .
IF_FINB_GN_RAW_VIEW            I SET_TECH_SETTINGS             Sets the Technical Settings                                 .
IF_FINB_GN_SERVICE_DISPLAY     I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Provides List of Objects to Be Displayed                    .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I COMPARE_FIELDLIST             Checks whether New Field List Requires Conversion           .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I DELETE_ALL_DATA               Only for Tables: Deletes All Data                           .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I GET_CLIENT_SPECIFIC           Gets Client-Dependency of the Table                         .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I GET_COMPONENT                 Provides Individual Component                               .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I GET_COMPONENTS                Provides Components from the Structure                      .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I GET_NAMETAB                   Provides DDIC Name Tab                                      .
IF_FINB_GN_STRUC               I GET_WORK_AREA                 Provides Work Area from the Structure                       .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I BUILD_SOURCE                  Generates/Modifies the Source Data or Language Vector       .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I BUILD_TADIR_ENTRY             Generates/Modifies the TADIR Entry                          .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I GET_KIND                      Provides the Object Type                                    .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I GET_LANGUAGE                  Provides the Object Language                                .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I GET_NAME                      Provides the Object Description                             .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I GET_SOURCE_TYPE               Provides Type of Source Data for the Object                 .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I GET_TADIR_KEY                 Provides Key for the TADIR Entry                            .
IF_FINB_GN_TRANSFER_OBJECT     I REPLACE_OBJ_NAME              Replaces Physical Name of the Object in the Source          .
IF_FINB_GS_PROG_CALLBACK       I GET_COMMENTS                  Returns Comment Rows for Generated Program                  .
IF_FINB_GS_PROG_CALLBACK       I GET_NAME_ORIGINAL_PROG        Returns Name of Source Program for Generation               .
IF_FINB_GS_PROG_CALLBACK       I GET_OBJECT                    Generates Instance of Implementing Class                    .
IF_FINB_GS_PROG_CALLBACK       I GET_SEL_CALLBACK_KEY          Returns Key for Selection Includes to Be Used               .
IF_FINB_GS_PROG_CALLBACK       I GET_TITLE                     Returns New Title of Program to Be Generated if Necessary   .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_APPL_AREAID               Returns Key for Instancing of Characteristic Service        .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_COMMENTS                  Returns Comment Rows for Generated Includes                 .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_GENERATION_INFO           Gives Names of Selection/Event Includes to Be Generated     .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_OBJECT                    Generates Instance of Implementing Class                    .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_SCR_GROUPS                Returns Field Groups for Selection Screen                   .
IF_FINB_GS_SEL_CALLBACK        I GET_SEL_PARS                  Returns Parameters for Selection Screen                     .
IF_FINB_KF_CHARS_LIST          I GET_LIST                      List of Characteristics                                     .
IF_FINB_KF_CHARS_LIST          I GET_STRUCTURE                 Characteristic Structure                                    .
IF_FINB_KF_CHARS_TABLE_W_KEY   I GET_KEY_FIELDS                Key Characteristics                                         .
IF_FINB_KF_CHARS_TABLE_W_KEY   I GET_NON_KEY_FIELDS            Non-Key Characteristics                                     .
IF_FINB_KF_CHARS_WHERE_USED    I GET_KF_CHAR_LIST              Provides Kist of Field Names of the Used Chars and Key Figs .
IF_FINB_LG_ACTIVATION          I ACTIVATE                      Activation of One or Several Languages                      .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check for Existence of Characteristic Values                .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I CHECK_SINGLE_EXISTENCE        Check for Existence of a Characteristic Value               .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I CONVERT_INPUT                 Entry Conversion                                            .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I CONVERT_OUTPUT                Output Conversion                                           .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I GET_META_DATA                 Provides Metadata                                           .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I READ_SINGLE_VALUE             Read Characteristic Value and Attributes of Char. Value     .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR                I READ_VALUE                    Read Characteristic Values and Attributes of Char. Values   .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I DISCARD_BUFFER                Reset Buffer for All Registrations                          .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I GET_CHAR_INSTANCE             Get Characteristic Instance                                 .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Mill Instance                                           .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I GET_REGISTRY_INSTANCE         Get Registration Instance                                   .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I IS_ESA_AVAILABLE              Checks Whether ESA Available                                .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_FACTORY        I IS_MDF_AVAILABLE              Checks Whether MDF Available                                .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL       I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Get Data References                                         .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL       I DISCARD_BUFFER                Reset Buffer                                                .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL       I DISCARD_BUFFER_INSTANCE       Reset Buffer for Instance                                   .
IF_FINB_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL       I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Characteristic Instance                                 .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY            I CHECK                         Check Registration                                          .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY            I DELETE_REGISTRY               Delete Registration                                         .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY            I GET_REGISTRY                  Ascertain Registered Entities                               .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY            I SAVE                          Save Registration                                           .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY            I SET_REGISTRY                  Transfer Entities to Be Registered                          .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRYENTITY      I COPY                          Returns Copy of Instance                                    .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRYENTITY      I EQUALS                        Compare Attributes                                          .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I DISCARD_BUFFER                Get Registration Instance                                   .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_INSTANCE                  Reset Buffer                                                .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_MDF_ID                    Gets MDF Application and MDF-AREAID                         .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_REGISTRYENTITY            Get Registration Entity                                     .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_SID                       Registration SID                                            .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_STRUCTURE_NAME            Gets Name of Generated Structure                            .
IF_FINB_MD_REGISTRY_INTERNAL   I GET_TEMP_FIELDNAME            Gets Temporary MDF Field Name for a Field Name              .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I COLLECT_MSG_OF_TYPE           Provides True if Messages of Type Are to Be Collected       .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_APPLICATION               Returns the Application                                     .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_APPL_LOG_PROFILE          Provides Profiles for Displaying the Application Log        .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_CONTEXT_FIELDS            Provides Field Name of the Flat Context Structure           .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_CONTEXT_MESSAGE_FOR_APPL  Provides Message for Application Context Message            .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_CONTEXT_MESSAGE_FROM_GUID Provides Message for Group Context Message                  .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_CONTEXT_STRUCTURE_WITH_KEYStrucure Name (Must Include FINB_MSG_CONTEXT!!!)            .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER_CXT   Provides Appl. Log Info for Assigned Message Handler        .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_HDR_CONTEXT               Gets Value of Header Context                                .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_MIN_TYPE_TO_COLLECT       Provides Minimum Error Type for Message Collection          .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I GET_TYPE_OF_PROPAGATION       Provides error type from which the message is propagated    .
IF_FINB_MSG_APPL_CONTEXT       I READ_GUID_BY_KEY              Provides GUID for Assigned Key                              .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I ASSOCIATE_TO_DEFAULT_HANDLER  Instance is associated with the default message handler     .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I CHANGE_DEFAULT_LEVEL_CONTEXT  Sets New Parent Default Context                             .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I CLEAR_MSG_CONTEXT             Deletes Structured Message Context                          .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I CREATE_MSG_CONTEXT            Generates a Message Context Object                          .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I DELETE_CONTEXT_FROM_DB        Deletes Context Information for an Application Log          .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I DISPLAY_MSG_CONTEXT_DETAIL    Displays Additional Information                             .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I FLUSH_COLLECTED_TO_MSG_HANDLERPasses Context Messages to Default Msg. Handler             .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_DEFAULT_CONTEXT_VALUE     Gets Values of Current Default Context                      .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER_CXT   Provides Appl. Log Info for the Default Message Handler     .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_INSTANCE                  Provides an Instance of the Message Context Factory         .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_MESSAGE_COUNT             Gets Total of Assigned Messages from All Contexts           .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_MSG_CONTEXT               Fetches an Existing Message Context Object                  .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I GET_TYPE_OF_PROPAGATION       Provides error type from which the message is propagated    .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I MARK_MSG_CONTEXT_DETAIL       Selects Additional Information for a Message Context        .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I POP_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER       Functionality to Restore a MSG Handler                      .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I PUSH_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER      Functionality to Park a MSG Handler                         .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACTORY    I SAVE_MARKED                   Saves Selected Additional Information on the Database       .
IF_FINB_MSG_CONTEXT_FACT_OWNER I GET_FACTORY_OWNER             Gets Owner of Factory                                       .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I ADD_FROM_MSG_HANDLER          Adds Messages from Other Message Collector                  .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds a Single Message                                       .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I ADD_MESSAGES                  Adds Several Messages                                       .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I ADD_SY_MESSAGE                Adds a Message (Based on the System Fields)                 .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I ADD_UGMD_MESSAGES             Adds UGMD Messages                                          .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I CLEAR                         Deletes All Messages Gathered from the Message Handler      .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I CONVERT2BAPIRET2              Gets Messages in BAPIRETZ                                   .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I CREATE_SY_MESSAGE             Generates System Message with Link to Application Log       .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I DISPLAY                       Displays the Collected Messages                             .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I GET_LAST_MESSAGE              Provides Last Message with Specified Gravity                .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I GET_LOG_HANDLE                Provides the application log handle                         .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I GET_MESSAGES                  Supplies all Collected Messages                             .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I GET_MESSAGE_COUNT             Gets Number of Messages (opt.  "=Problem Class)             .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I SAVE                          Saves the Collected Messages                                .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER            I SET_DISPLAY_DEFAULTS          Sets Appl.-Related Display Structure for Internal Context   .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_CALLBACK   I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Determines the Propagation Strategy for Message Handling    .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I CREATE_CONSTANT_CALLBACK      Creates a Callback Instance (with Constant Behavior)        .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I CREATE_DYNAMIC_CALLBACK       Creates a Callback Instance (with Dynamic Behavior)         .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I CREATE_MSG_HANDLER            Creates a Message Handler Instance                          .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I DEFAULT_LEVEL_CHANGED_BY      Message to refer to context change                          .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I DEFAULT_LEVEL_FLUSHED_BY      Message to restore default level                            .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I GET_DEFAULT_CONTEXT_FACTORY   Gets Assigned Context_Factory for Default Handler           .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I GET_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER       Deliver default message handler instance                    .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I GET_DEFAULT_MSG_LEVEL         Deliver current message level                               .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I SET_DEFAULT_MSG_HANDLER       (Internal only) May not be used by the application!         .
IF_FINB_MSG_HANDLER_FACTORY    I SET_MSG_HANDLER_CONTEXT       Sets Context Infor for Later Creation of Instances          .
IF_FINB_MSG_TOP_LEVEL_HANDLER  I CREATE_DEFAULT_HANDLER        Generates New Default Handler Instance                      .
IF_FINB_MSG_TOP_LEVEL_HANDLER  I GET_OWNER_DEFAULT_HANDLER     Provides Owner of Default Level Handler                     .
IF_FINB_MSG_TOP_LEVEL_HANDLER  I GET_TOP_LEVEL_HANDLER         Provides Top-Level Collector (Only for Context Factories)   .
IF_FINB_MSG_TOP_LEVEL_HANDLER  I IS_DEFAULT_LEVEL_HANDLER      True, if msg_handler Is Default Handler                     .
IF_FINB_NAVIGATION_SERVICE     I DISPLAY_DOCUMENT              Display a Document                                          .
IF_FINB_OBJ_META_DESCRIPT      I GET_LANGUAGE_VECTOR           Provdes Language Vector from the Texts (Implem. Optional)   .
IF_FINB_OBJ_META_DESCRIPT      I GET_META_DESCRIPT             Gets Descriptive Data for the Object                        .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I ACTIVATE_ALL_OBJ              Activation of All Persistence Objects                       .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I CREATE_BALANCE_OBJ            Create Balance Object                                       .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I CREATE_PERSIST_OBJ            Create a Persistence Object                                 .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I CREATE_PERSIST_TAB            Creation of a Persistence Table                             .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I CREATE_PROXY_OBJ              Creates a Proxy Object                                      .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I CREATE_TOTALS_OBJ             Create Totals Object                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I DELETE_PERSIST_OBJ            Delete a Persistence Object                                 .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I GET_PERSIST_OBJ               Provides Persistence Object (Runtime Object)                .
IF_FINB_PR_CONFIGURATOR        I SHOW_OBJECTS                  Display Objects                                             .
IF_FINB_PR_CONTAINER           I CLEAR                         Deletes Contents of All Container Tables                    .
IF_FINB_PR_FIELD               I GET_DATA_ELEMENT              Provides Name of the Data Element                           .
IF_FINB_PR_FIELD               I GET_DOMNAME                   Provides Domain Name                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_FIELD               I GET_FIELD_TEXT                Provides Text                                               .
IF_FINB_PR_FIELD               I GET_SUPERIOR_CHARS            Provides Parent Characteristics (Compounding)               .
IF_FINB_PR_HIER_READER         I CLOSE_CURSOR                  Closing the Cursor                                          .
IF_FINB_PR_HIER_READER         I FETCH                         Fetching the Data                                           .
IF_FINB_PR_HIER_READER         I OPEN_CURSOR                   Opening the Cursor                                          .
IF_FINB_PR_HIER_READER         I SELECT                        Selection                                                   .
IF_FINB_PR_IMPLEMENTATION      I GET_IMPLEMENTATION            Provides Implementation of an Interface                     .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I ADD_CHILD                     Adds an extra existing persistence object                   .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I CHECK_DATA_EXISTENCE          Checks Existence of Data                                    .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I COLLECT_OBJS                  Collects All Objects of a Persistence Hierarchy             .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I DELETE_CHILD                  Deletes Parent-Child Assignment                             .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_ABAP_STRU                 Gets ABAP Structure                                         .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_FIELD_IDS                 Provides field IDs for the object                           .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_GENERATED_OBJ             Gets Generated Object for Logical Name                      .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_GENERATED_OBJS            Provides Generated Objects                                  .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_INDEX                     Provides an Index                                           .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_KF_CHARS_STRUCTURE        Gets Instances of CL_FINB_KF_CHARS_STRUCTURE                .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I GET_OBJ_NAME                  Gets Physical Name for Logical Name                         .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I SET_DEFAULT_JOIN_COND         Sets Standard Join Condition to One/All Lower-Level Object(s.
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ                 I SET_JOIN_COND                 Sets Join Condition to a Lower-Level Object                 .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I ACTIVATE                      Activates persistence object and all lower-level nodes      .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I ADD_INDEX                     Addition of an Index                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I CHECK_CRIT_CHANGES            Checks for Critical Changes                                 .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I DELETE_INDEX                  Delete index                                                .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I SAVE                          Save persistence object and all lower-level nodes           .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I SET_AFTER_CNV_HANDLER         Sets Post-Processing Tool for Conversion                    .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I SET_INACTIVE                  Sets Object Inactive                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG          I SHOW_OBJECT                   Object Display                                              .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I ACTIVATE_OBJECT               2nd Activation Session: Activate Persistence Objects        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I CHECK_GEN_OBJECTS             Checks Generated Objects and Sets A_VERSION                 .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I DEQUEUE_OBJECT                Unlocks Object and All Lower-Level Objects                  .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I EXECUTE_BUILDING_PLAN         1st Activation Session: Generate Repository Objects         .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I GENERATE_1                    Generates Repository Objects - Step 1                       .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I GENERATE_2                    Generates Repository Objects - Step 2                       .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I PREPARE_TRANS_GEN             Prepares Generation of Totals/Index Update                  .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I SAVE_OBJECT                   Save Persistence Object and All Children (Internal)         .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_CONFIG_INT      I SET_INST_VERSION              Sets/Updates Attribute A_INST_VERSION                       .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_FACTORY         I CLOSE_FACTORY                 Closes the Plant (Memory Release, Persists Msg Log.)        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_FACTORY         I COLLECT_LOGS                  Gathers Logs for the Objects                                .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_FACTORY         I DESTROY_RUN_TIME_OBJ          Destroys Runtime Object of a Persistence Object             .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_FACTORY         I DISPLAY_LOG                   Displayd the Complete Logs                                  .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_FACTORY         I GET_CATALOG                   Gets Catalog Entries for an Area ID                         .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN             I CHECK_TOTALS                  Compares Line Items with Totals/Balances                    .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN             I GET_NEW_CONTAINER             Provides Data Container                                     .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN             I GET_NEW_HIERARCHY_READER      Provides Hierarchy Reader                                   .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN             I GET_NEW_JOIN_READER           Provides Join Reader                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN             I GET_WRITER                    Provides Update Task                                        .
IF_FINB_PR_OBJ_RUN_INT         I GENERATE_FROM_CLAUSE          Generates FROM Clause of the SELECT Statement               .
IF_FINB_PR_REQUEST_DISPATCHER  I CREATE_PERSIST_OBJ            Create a Persistence Object                                 .
IF_FINB_PR_REQUEST_DISPATCHER  I CREATE_PROXY_OBJ              Creates a Proxy Object                                      .
IF_FINB_PR_REQUEST_DISPATCHER  I GET_PERSIST_OBJ               Provides Persistence Object (Runtime Object)                .
IF_FINB_PR_TABLE               I GET_BALANCE_TIME_CHARS        Gets Time Characteristics for Balance                       .
IF_FINB_PR_TABLE               I GET_TABLE                     Gets Internal Table for Persistence Table                   .
IF_FINB_PR_TABLE               I GET_TABLE_DESCRIPTION         Provides Metadata for a Persistence Table                   .
IF_FINB_PR_TABLE               I GET_TABLE_NAME                Provides Physical Names of the Table                        .
IF_FINB_PR_TABLE               I GET_TOTALS_ID                 Provides CONFIG_ID of Relevant TOTAL Object                 .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I ADD_FIELD                     Add Data Field                                              .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I DELETE_FIELD                  Delete Field                                                .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I GENERATE_OPTIONAL_OBJS        Generation of Optional Objects                              .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I MODIFY_TABLE_DESCRIPTION      Create/Change Persistence Table                             .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I SET_INDEX_TABLE               Assigns an Existing Table as Index Table                    .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I SET_TABLE                     Assigns an Existing Table                                   .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_CONFIG          I USE_EXISTING_TAB              Uses Existing Table (Only Use After Consultation)           .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_RUN             I REORG_INDICES                 Reorganizes Cross-Table Indexes                             .
IF_FINB_PR_TAB_RUN             I REORG_TOTALS                  Reorganizes Assigned Totals/Balances Objects                .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I GET_DELETE_CONTAINER          Delivers Container for Data to Be Deleted                   .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I GET_INSERT_CONTAINER          Delivers Container for Data to Be Inserted                  .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I GET_MODIFY_CONTAINER          Delivers Container for Data to Be Inserted/Changed          .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I GET_UPDATE_CONTAINER          Delivers Container for Data to Be Changed                   .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I POST                          Deduct Post Order                                           .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I POST_IMMEDIATE                Direct Posting                                              .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I POST_ON_COMMIT                POST is performed automatically during Commit Work          .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_DELETE_CONTAINER          Container with Data to Be Deleted                           .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_INSERT_CONTAINER          Container with Data to Be Inserted                          .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_MODIFY_CONTAINER          Container with Data to Be Inserted/Changed                  .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_SCHEDMAN_KEY              Sets Key for Schedule Manager                               .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_UPDATE_CONTAINER          Container with Data to Be Changed                           .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I SET_UPDATE_SET_CLAUSE         Data to Be Changed (By Column)                              .
IF_FINB_PR_WRITER              I TO_BE_DELETE_DATA             Data to Be Deleted                                          .
IF_FINB_READER                 I GET_SELECT_FIELDS             Obsolete; GET_READING_STRUCTURE, ...-"Use GET_LIST          .
IF_FINB_READER                 I OPEN_CURSOR                   Open Cursor                                                 .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I CHANGE_CONDITION              Possible Change of Selection Conditions by Application      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I CHECK                         Data Checked by Application                                 .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Data Checked by Application Before Posting                  .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I DELETE                        Transfers Deleted Data Records to the Application (Buffer)  .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_AUTHORITY_CHECK           Gets Authorization Check for Reporting                      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_EVENTS                    Gets Events (Navigation and Additional User Functions)      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_EXTENDED_READER           Temporary: Returns Reader Interface of Reporting Tools      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_JOIN_READER               Returns Join Reader Interface of Application                .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_LAYOUT                    Gets Layout Information                                     .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I GET_READER                    Returns Reader Interface of Application                     .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I INSERT                        Transfers Inserted Data Records to Application (Buffer)     .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I SAVE                          Data Update                                                 .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_APPL_SERVICE I UPDATE                        Transfers Changed Data Records to Application (Buffer)      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_RUNTIME      I CHECK_LAYOUT_EXISTENCE        Checks if transferred layout for report display exists      .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_RUNTIME      I DISPLAY_LAYOUT_INPUT_HELP     Displays Entry Help for Layouts                             .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_SERVICE      I CALL_AND_RETURN               Let the show begin!                                         .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_SERVICE      I REFRESH                       Update Display Data                                         .
IF_FINB_REPORTING_SERVICE      I SET_DETAIL_PARAMETERS         Settings for a Detail List                                  .
IF_FINB_REPORT_CONFIGURATOR    I DELETE_REPORT                 Report Deletion                                             .
IF_FINB_REPORT_CONFIGURATOR    I GENERATE_REPORT_RETURN_HANDLE Report Generation                                           .
IF_FINB_REPORT_CONFIGURATOR    I SET_DISPLAY_CHARS             Set the Display Properties                                  .
IF_FINB_REPORT_CONFIGURATOR    I SET_SELECTION_CHARS           Set the Selection Properties                                .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I GET_REF_TO_TABLE              Gets Reference to Original Table                            .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I INSERT                        Inserts a Row and Returns a Reference to it                 .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I SELECT                        Selection Using Condition or SELTAB                         .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I SELECT_MULTI_BY_KEY           Selection of many Entries Using a Key                       .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I SELECT_MULTI_BY_PARTIAL_KEY   Selection Using Partial Key                                 .
IF_FINB_RT_FULL_ACCESS_TABLE   I SELECT_SINGLE                 Selection of a Single Record                                .
IF_FINB_RT_READER              I GET_COMPONENTS                Gets Components of Runtime Table                            .
IF_FINB_RT_READER              I SELECT                        Selection Using Condition or SELTAB                         .
IF_FINB_RT_READER              I SELECT_BY_PARTIAL_KEY         Selection Using Partial Key                                 .
IF_FINB_RT_READER              I SELECT_MULTI_BY_KEY           Selection of many Entries Using a Key                       .
IF_FINB_RT_READER              I SELECT_SINGLE                 Selection of a Single Record                                .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I DELETE                        Deletes Table Rows                                          .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I DELETE_BY_PARTIAL_KEY         Deletes Table Rows using Partial Key                        .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I GET_COMPONENTS                Gets Components of Runtime Table                            .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I GET_TABLE                     Gets Total Table                                            .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I INSERT                        Adds New Rows                                               .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I REFRESH                       Deletes Contents of Table                                   .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I SELECT                        Selection Using Condition or SELTAB                         .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I SELECT_BY_PARTIAL_KEY         Selection Using Partial Key                                 .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I SELECT_MULTI_BY_KEY           Selection of many Entries Using a Key                       .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I SELECT_SINGLE                 Selection of a Single Record                                .
IF_FINB_RT_TABLE               I UPDATE                        Changes Table Rows                                          .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_OBJECT          I GET_AMOUNT                    Read Amount with Currency                                   .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_OBJECT          I GET_QUANTITY                  Read Quantity with Unit                                     .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE            I GET_ADDITIONAL_KEY            Provides Any Additionally Required Key for Field Access     .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE            I GET_ALL_COMPONENTS            Gets All Components, also from Subtypes                     .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE            I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Language-Dependent Type Description                    .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE            I GET_FIELD_NAMES               Provides Names of All (Flat) Components of Field Type       .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE            I GET_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT        Gets Persistence Object for Type                            .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE_FACTORY    I GET_TYPE                      Gets an Instance of Type                                    .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE_FACTORY    I GET_TYPES                     Gets All Instances for Metatype in Data Basis               .
IF_FINB_STRUCT_TYPE_MAINT      I SAVE                          Save configuration                                          .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I COMPRESS_TABKEYS              Compress the Key                                            .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I FORCE_TYPE_GENERATION         Force Regeneration of the Temporary Types                   .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GENERATE_TYPES                Generate All Temporary Types for the Known Order            .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GENERATE_TYPES_FOR_TABLES     Generate New Types for New Tables                           .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_ALL_DATA                  Read All Data for the Object                                .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_DATA                      Read Data                                                   .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_DATAINFO                  Read Directory of Stored Data                               .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_SELOPTS                   Read Select Options                                         .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_SELOPT_FOR_KEY            Provide Select Options for a Key                            .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_STRUCTURE                 Read Structure Information                                  .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_TABKEYS                   Read Tables and Key                                         .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I GET_TYPE_FACTORY              Gets Instance to Factory for Types                          .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I REPLACE_TABKEYS               Completely Replace Tables and Key                           .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I SAVE_DATA                     Save Data                                                   .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I SAVE_DATA_WITH_MSG            Save Data with Message Handling                             .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I SAVE_STRUCTURE                Save Structure Information                                  .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I SAVE_TABKEYS                  Save Tables and Key                                         .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER           I WRITE_SELOPT_FOR_KEY          Change Select Option for a Key                              .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I EXPORT_SELOPTS                Export Select Options                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I EXPORT_STRUCTURE              Structure Information Export                                .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I EXPORT_TABLEKEYS              Table and Key Export                                        .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_DATA                   Table Key Data Import                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_DATAINFO               Data Information Import                                     .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_DATA_01                Import Data to a Table Key Version 01                       .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_SELOPTS                Import Select Options                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_STRUCTURE              Structure Information Import                                .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_ACCESS    I IMPORT_TABLEKEYS              Table and Key Import                                        .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I GET_TABLES_FOR_OBJECT         Read All Texts Tables for an Object                         .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I GET_TEXT                      Read Table Row (Text) for a Key                             .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I GET_TEXT_BY_NV                Read Table Row (Text) for a Key (Named Values)              .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I GET_TRANSPORT_ENTRIES         Fetch Transport Entries for Text Table                      .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I SAVE                          Store Changed Data Records                                  .
IF_FINB_TR_CONTAINER_TEXT      I SAVE_TEXT                     Store Table Row (Text) for a Key                            .
IF_FINB_TR_LOGO_OBJECT         I ADD_KEY                       Add Key for Logical Object                                  .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CC_CLII      I CC_CHECK_SOURCE_CLIENT        CLIIDEP: Check (Source) Client                              .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CC_CLII      I CC_EXCLUDE_TABLES_CLII        CLIIDEP: Exclude (Source) Tables from Client Copy           .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CC_DATA      I CC_DELETE_CLIENT              Delete All Objects and Spec. Data for a Client              .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CC_DATA      I CC_GET_SOURCE_TABNAMES        Source System: Get Names of Generated Tables                .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CC_DATA      I CC_GET_TARGET_TABNAMES        Target System: Get Names of Generated Tables                .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CLIENTCOPY   I CC_COLLECT_OBJECTS            (Source) Collect Transport Objects for Client Copy          .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CLIENTCOPY   I CC_EXCLUDE_TABLES             (Source) Exclude Tables of Client Copy                      .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CLIENTCOPY   I CC_FINISH                     (Target) End After Import Post-Processing                   .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_CLIENTCOPY   I CC_INIT                       (Target) Initialization before Import Post-Processing       .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_EXPORT       I EXECUTE_BEFORE_EXPORT         Execute Before-Import Method                                .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_GENERIC_TEXT I GET_SPLIT_AND_LOG_KEY         Delivers Split Key and Logical Key                          .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_GENERIC_TEXT I GET_TABLE_ID                  Delivers a Unique ID for a Text Table                       .
IF_FINB_TR_METHOD_IMPORT       I EXECUTE_AFTER_IMPORT          Execute After-Import Method                                 .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I AFTER_IMPORT                  Execute After-Import Method                                 .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I BEFORE_EXPORT                 Execute Before-Import Method                                .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I GET_PIECE_LIST                Get Bill of Materials                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I GET_TRANSPORT                 Get Transport Objects                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I GET_TRKORR                    Order Number for Container Accesses                         .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I HAS_GENERIC_TEXT              Record Generic Text Table                                   .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_CLIENT_DEP                 Query about Client-Specificity of the Object                .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_CONTAINER                  Query about Container Transport                             .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_LOGO_OBJECT                Check for Logical Transport Object                          .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_MAINTAINABLE               Chedk Maintainability                                       .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_TABU_OBJECT                Check for Table Object                                      .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I IS_TRANSPORTABLE              Query about Transportability of the Object                  .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I SET_TRANSPORTABLE             Set Transportability                                        .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT              I SET_TRKORR                    Order Number for Container Accesses                         .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_CHECK_SOURCE_CLIENT        CLIIDEP: Check (Source) Client                              .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_COLLECT_OBJECTS            Collect Transport Objects for Client Copy                   .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_DELETE_CLIENT              Delete All Objects and Spec. Data for a Client              .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_EXCLUDE_TABLES             Exclude Tables of Client Copy                               .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_EXCLUDE_TABLES_CLII        CLIIDEP: Exclude (Source) Tables from Client Copy           .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_FINISH                     End After-Import Post-Processing                            .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_GET_SOURCE_TABNAMES        Source System: Get Names of Generated Tables                .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_GET_TARGET_TABNAMES        Target System: Get Names of Generated Tables                .
IF_FINB_TR_OBJECT_CC           I CC_INIT                       Initialization of Before-Import Post-Processing             .
IF_FINB_TR_REQUEST             I ADD_OBJECT                    Add Object to Transport Request                             .
IF_FINB_TR_REQUEST             I GET_OBJECTS                   Return List of Transport Objects                            .
IF_FINB_TR_REQUEST             I GET_REQUEST                   Query Request                                               .
IF_FINB_TR_REQUEST             I GET_TRANSPORT_CONTAINER       Return Transport Container Instance                         .
IF_FINB_TR_REQUEST             I SAVE_REQUEST                  Write Request                                               .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I ADD_ITAB                      Add (Flat) Internal Table                                   .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I ADD_SELOPTION                 Add a Selection Condition                                   .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I ADD_TABLE_KEY                 Insert a Table Key                                          .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I GET_ITAB_FOR_KEY              Get Internal Table for a Key                                .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I GET_ITAB_STRUCTURE            Get Structure Description of an Internal Table              .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I GET_SELOPTS                   Return all Selection Options                                .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I GET_TABLE_KEYS                Return All Tables and Keys                                  .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I MERGE_TABLE_KEYS              Add Table Key and Selection Conditions                      .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I REMOVE_TABLE_KEY              Delete a Table Key                                          .
IF_FINB_TR_TABU_OBJECT         I SET_TABLE_KEYS                Reset Table Key and Selection Conditions                    .
IF_FINDR_DERIVATION_STEP       I CHECK                         TODO: Check Step                                            .
IF_FINDR_DERIVATION_STEP       I CREATE                        Generate Step                                               .
IF_FINDR_DERIVATION_STEP       I PROCESS                       Execute step                                                .
IF_FIN_DUEDATE_OBJECT          I DELETE_ENTRIES                Delete Purchase Orders                                      .
IF_FIN_DUEDATE_OBJECT          I READ_ENTRIES                  Read Purchase Order                                         .
IF_FIN_DUEDATE_OBJECT          I WRITE_ENTRIES                 Add/Change Purchase Orders                                  .
IF_FIN_ORDPUR_OBJECT           I DELETE_ENTRIES                Delete Purchase Orders                                      .
IF_FIN_ORDPUR_OBJECT           I READ_ENTRIES                  Read Purchase Order                                         .
IF_FIN_ORDPUR_OBJECT           I WRITE_ENTRIES                 Add/Change Purchase Orders                                  .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GEN_DECLARATION               Generate Declarations for Interval Module Include           .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GEN_LOOP                      Generate Loop Begin                                         .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GEN_READ_DATA                 Generate Master Data Import                                 .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GEN_READ_DATA_INIT            Generate Master Data Import, Initial Part                   .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GEN_REQ_FIELDS                Generate List of Required Open Item Fields                  .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I GET_STRUCT_NAME               Itabname Function                                           .
IF_FKKBW_BWMDS                 I INIT_GEN                      Initialize Customizing                                      .
IF_FKKFM_CHECKS                I FKKFM_CHECKS_METH1            Update Write-Offs as Invoice                                .
IF_FKKFM_CHECKS                I FKKFM_CHECKS_METH2            Force Account Assignment Derivation for Commitment Item     .
IF_FKKOI_XI                    I SEND_INFORMATION              Send Information to XI                                      .
IF_FKK_CORR_DISP_HISTORY_COMM  I BEFORE_LOOP                   Multiple Selection: Processed before the Loop               .
IF_FKK_CORR_DISP_HISTORY_COMM  I DO                            Execute Method for Command                                  .
IF_FKK_CORR_DISP_HISTORY_COMM  I IS_ACTIVE                     Test whether Method is Active                               .
IF_FKK_CORR_OUTPUT_REQUEST     I OUTPUT_CORR_REQUEST           Output Correspondence Request                               .
IF_FKK_CREDIT_CHECK            I PERFORM                       Perform Credit Check                                        .
IF_FKK_CREDIT_EVENT_IN         I CONVERT_INBOUND               XI =" SAP                                                   .
IF_FKK_CREDIT_EVENT_IN         I STORE_ENTRIES                 Write Entries to Database                                   .
IF_FKK_CREDIT_INFO             I READ_MASTER_DATA              Read Credit Limit and Score                                 .
IF_FKK_CREDIT_VECTOR           I PUSH_CREDIT_VECTOR            Send Payment Behavior Summary to SAP Credit Management      .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I CONVERT_INBOUND               XI =" SAP                                                   .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I CREATE_IDOC                   Create IDoc with XI Message Information                     .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_BPITEM                    Determination of Business Partner Item                      .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_GLITEM                    Determination of General Ledger Items                       .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_HEADER                    Determination of Header Line                                .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_INTERNAL_BUSINESS_PARTNER Determination of Internal Business Partner ID               .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_INTERNAL_CONTRACT_ACCOUNT Determination of Intrenal Contract Account ID               .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_SYSTEM_ASSIGNMENT         Read Customizing for External Billing                       .
IF_FKK_EXTERNAL_BILLING_IN     I GET_TAXITEM                   Determination of Tax Items                                  .
IF_FKK_GET_CRITICAL_GPART      I GET_CRITICAL_GPART            Determine Critical Business Partners in Credit Management   .
IF_FKK_LIABILITY_PULL          I CONVERT_INBOUND               XI =" SAP                                                   .
IF_FKK_LIABILITY_PULL          I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              SAP =" XI                                                   .
IF_FKK_LIABILITY_PULL          I GET_LIABILITY                 Provision of Current Liability                              .
IF_FKK_LIABILITY_PUSH          I PUSH_LIABILITY                Update FI-CA Liabilities in SAP Credit Management           .
IF_FKK_SCORING_GET             I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to FI-CA                          .
IF_FKK_SCORING_GET             I GET_CR_SCORING                Receives Score from XI                                      .
IF_FKK_SCORING_PUSH            I PUSH_SCORING                  Send Score to SAP Credit Management                         .
IF_FLUSH_NOTIFY                I BEFORE_FLUSH_NOTIFY           Notification of Flush                                       .
IF_FLUSH_TRANSPORT_MM          I CAN_INITIATE_FLUSH            Which Object is Responsible for Flush                       .
IF_FLUSH_TRANSPORT_MM          I START                         Start Transport                                             .
IF_FMAVC_DEFAULT_LEDGER        I GET_AVC_LEDGER_POSTING        Derive default AVC ledger for posting data                  .
IF_FMAVC_ENTRY                 I COLLECT_BUD                   Collect data for FM budgeting                               .
IF_FMAVC_ENTRY                 I COLLECT_RIB                   Collect data from RIB                                       .
IF_FMAVC_ENTRY                 I COLLECT_UPD                   Collect data for FM posting                                 .
IF_FMAVC_LEDGER                I COLLECT_BUD                   Collect budgeting data for AVC check                        .
IF_FMAVC_LEDGER                I COLLECT_RIB                   Collect RIB data (RIB call procedures) for AVC check        .
IF_FMAVC_LEDGER                I COLLECT_UPD                   Collect FM posting data for AVC check                       .
IF_FMAVC_RIB                   I GET_ENTRIES                   Get entries from the RIB ledger                             .
IF_FMBAS_DERIVATION_TOOL       I ACTIVATE_CHANGE_DOC           Activation of the change document functionality             .
IF_FMBW_FMAA_HIER              I CHANGE_HIERARCHY_NAME         Name Change of Hierarchy for FM Account Assignments         .
IF_FMBW_RFFMBWBM               I IDENTIFY_INFO_OBJECTS         Identification of Info Objects with Document Characteristics.
IF_FMCA_BRF_EVENT              I SET_CONTEXT                   Set Context                                                 .
IF_FMCE_CHECK_LOGIC            I CG_CONTRIBUTION_CALCULATE     Calculate the Contrib. to a Cover Group From One Bdgt Addr. .
IF_FMCE_COVER_GROUP            I CHECK_COVER_GROUP             Verify new or modified cover group                          .
IF_FMFG_BL_EXT_USFED           I GET_BLEDGER_AREAS             Change the budgetary ledger areas for the BL derivation     .
IF_FMFG_BL_EXT_USFED           I GET_BUDGET_STATE              Change the budget state for the BL derivation               .
IF_FMFG_CCR_DATAREAD           I READ_HEADER                   Read CCR data header record                                 .
IF_FMFG_CCR_MESSAGE_CUST       I MESSAGE_ACTUALS               Actuals: Customize messaging                                .
IF_FMFG_CCR_MESSAGE_CUST       I MESSAGE_OI                    Open Items: Customize messaging                             .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I CLEAR_ITEM_GRID               Free memory used by ALV item display grid                   .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I DELETE_SAVED_RESULTS          Delete saved result data for a REPORT_ID value              .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GETPROVIDERLIST               Provide list of Data Providers available for the group      .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GET_LIST_AVAIL_VIEW_FIELDS    List of fields for sort/group/select for a rule             .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GET_MATCH_RESULTS             Retrieve match result data for a node                       .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GET_REPORT_CRITERIA           Provide report selection criteria as a table                .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GET_VIEW_FIELDS               Get sorting/grouping field names                            .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I GET_VIEW_TEXT                 Get text description of the selected view                   .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I INITIALIZE_FOR_CALCULATION    Initialize values for rule evaluation                       .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I POPUP_TO_SELECT_SAVED_RESULT  Dialog for saved result selection                           .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I PREPARE_FOR_RULE_CALCULATION  Initialization activities for rule execution                .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I REGISTER_GRID_EVT_HANDLER     Register event handlers for item display grid               .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I REGISTER_PROVIDER             Register a Data Provider for calculating an equation        .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I RETRIEVE_RESULTS_INITIAL      Initial portion of saving results: overall report data      .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I RETRIEVE_RESULTS_ITEM         Retrieve item level match data for a single node on the rpt .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SAVE_MATCH_RESULTS            Retrieve match result data for a node                       .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SAVE_RESULTS_INITIAL          Initial portion of saving results: overall report data      .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SET_BATCH_REPORT_CRITERIA     Provide report selection criteria as a table                .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SET_REPORT_CRITERIA           Set selection criteria for running a report                 .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SET_VIEW_FIELDS               Choose fields for sorting/grouping after subtotal level     .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SHOW_MATCH_RESULTS            Perform matching function and display results               .
IF_FMFG_RCN_GROUP              I SHOW_REPORT_CRITERIA          Display selection criteria for current report               .
IF_FMKF_HANDLER                I CHECK_BEFORE_EVALUATION       Check if the evalution has to be done or not                .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I GET_DRAGITEM                  Gets Budtxt ID that is Dragged or Dropped                   .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I GET_DRAGSRC                   Gets Budtxt ID of the Source of the Dragdrop Process        .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I GET_ICON_ID                   Gets Icon for Dragged Object                                .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I GET_TEXT                      Gets Text for Dragged Object                                .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I GET_USEROBJECT                Gets Additional Information (Free Field)                    .
IF_FMKU_DRAGDROPDATA           I SET_DRAGDATA                  Sets Information for DragDrop Process                       .
IF_FMRB_ENTRY                  I COLLECT_BUD                   Collect data for FM budgeting                               .
IF_FMRB_ENTRY                  I COLLECT_UPD                   Collect data for FM posting                                 .
IF_FMRB_RIB                    I CHECK_RULE                    Check new or modified RIB rule                              .
IF_FMRIB_AVC                   I COLLECT_RIB                   Hand over data to AVC collect                               .
IF_FM_DOCUMENT_VALIDATION      I CHECK_ACTUALS                 Actuals: Check document                                     .
IF_FM_DOCUMENT_VALIDATION      I CHECK_OI                      Commitm. Interf.: Check document                            .
IF_FM_EF_GROUP                 I CHECK_EF_GROUP                Check Group                                                 .
IF_FM_EF_GROUP                 I GROUPING_INIT                 Initialization Grouping Scenario                            .
IF_FM_EF_GROUP                 I PROCESS_OUTPUT_FIELDS         Fields Not Ready For Imput                                  .
IF_FM_EF_GROUP                 I SELECT_ALL_MEMBERS_OF_GROUP   Select All Document Items of a Group                        .
IF_FM_REQUEST_FLLW_DOC         I GET_FILTER_VALUE              Determine Filter Value                                      .
IF_FM_REQUEST_FLLW_DOC         I POST_FOLLOWING_DOCS           Post and Check Subsequent Documents                         .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I ADD_ADVICE_ITEM               Insert Payment Advice Note Item                             .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I COPY                          Copy Payment Advice Note                                    .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I CREATE_ADVICE                 Create New Payment Advice Note                              .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I CREATE_ADVICE_ON_DB           Create Payment Advice Note on Database                      .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I DELETE                        Delete Payment Advice Note                                  .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I DELETE_ADVICE_FROM_DB         Delete Payment Advice Note from Database                    .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I DEQUEUE                       Unblock Payment Advice Note                                 .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I DEQUEUE_ALL                   Unblock All Payment Advice Notes                            .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I ENQUEUE                       Block Payment Advice Note                                   .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I FACTORY_BY_ACCOUNT            All Payment Advice Notes for an Account Will Be Read        .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I FACTORY_BY_VBELN              All Payment Advice Notes for A Sales Order Will Be Read     .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I FORGET_ADVICE_ITEM            Payment Advice Note Will Be Removed                         .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET                           Read Current AVIK Values                                    .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET_ADVICE_ITEMS              All Payment Advice Note Items for a Payment Advice Note     .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET_ADVICE_ITEMS_BY_BSEG_KEY  Read Payment Advice Note Items from Buffer                  .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET_ADVICE_ITEMS_BY_VBAK_KEY  Read Payment Advice Note Items from Buffer                  .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET_ALL_DELETED_ADVICES       List of All Payment Advice Notes Held for Deletion          .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I GET_SINGLE_ITEM_BY_BSEG       Payment Advice Note Item for Line Item                      .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I NUMBER_OF_ADVICE_ITEMS        Number of Payment Advice Note Line Items                    .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I READ_ADVICE_FROM_DB           Read Complete Payment Advice Note from Database             .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I SET                           Write Current AVIK Values                                   .
IF_FOAP_AVIK                   I UNDO_DELETE                   Cancel Deletion of Payment Advice Note                      .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I ASSIGN_AMOUNT                 Assign Amount                                               .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I CLEAR_ASSIGNED_AMOUNT         Delete Assigned Amount                                      .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I CONVERT_CDITEM_TO_AVIP        Help Method for Creating Payment Advice Note Item           .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I GET                           Read Current AVIP Values                                    .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I GET_ADVICE_HEAD               Reference to Payment Advice Note Header                     .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I GET_ASSIGNED_AMOUNT           Read Assigned Amount                                        .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I SET                           Write Current AVIP Values                                   .
IF_FOAP_AVIP                   I TOTAL_ASSIGNED_AMOUNT         Total of Assigned Amounts                                   .
IF_FOAP_ITEM                   I GENERATE_ALV_LINE             Generate ALV Line                                           .
IF_FOAP_ITEM                   I GET_DOC_CURRENCY_KEY          Document Currency                                           .
IF_FOAP_ITEM                   I GET_LOCAL_CURRENCY_KEY        Local Currency                                              .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_BEFORE_SAVE            Called before FIN objects saved                             .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_CLOSE                  Checks FIN Objects before Closing                           .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_CREATE_EXPL            Checks and supplements FIN objects with explicit creation   .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_CREATE_IMPL            Checks and supplements FIN objects with implicit creation   .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_DELETE                 Checks FIN Objects Before Deletion                          .
IF_FOBJ_EVENT_HANDLER          I HANDLE_READ                   Checks and supplements FIN objects after reading from DB    .
IF_FOBJ_OBJECT                 I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets object description if available                        .
IF_FOBJ_OBJECT                 I GET_TEXTUAL_KEY               Gets business key as string                                 .
IF_FOBU_APPL_CALLBACK          I CONTEXT_MENU_OK_CODE          Process Function from Context Menu                          .
IF_FOBU_APPL_CALLBACK          I CONTEXT_MENU_REQUEST          Display Context Menu                                        .
IF_FOBU_APPL_CALLBACK          I PROCESS_OK_CODE               OK Code Handled by Application                              .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I CHECK                         Check Operand (Only for Pushbutton Operands)                .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I GET                           Get Operand                                                 .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I GET_ALL_OPERANDS              Get all operands (instead of using single calls via GET)    .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I PARSE_OP_GET                  Get Operand During Parse (Only Pushbutton Operands)         .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I PUSHBUTTONS_GET               Get Pushbuttons                                             .
IF_FOBU_CONNECTOR              I PUSHBUTTON_OP_GET             Get Operand for Pushbutton (Pushbutton was clicked)         .
IF_FOBU_STORAGE                I DELETE                        Delete Formula from Database                                .
IF_FOBU_STORAGE                I GET_TRANSPORT_KEYS            Get Transport Data                                          .
IF_FOBU_STORAGE                I READ                          Read Formula from Database                                  .
IF_FOBU_STORAGE                I READ_CLIENT                   Reade Formula from Database with Client Specification       .
IF_FOBU_STORAGE                I SAVE                          Save Formula to Database                                    .
IF_FOEV_CONNECTOR              I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Parameter/Field                                    .
IF_FOEV_CUST_BADI_BRF          I SET_FUNC                      Set New Functions for BRF Expressions in SAP Formula Editor .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I ADD_RECIPIENT                 Add Recipient to Scheduled Task                             .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I FINISH_EXECUTION              Call upon Finished Execution                                .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I GET_INBOX_INFO                To Read Particular Inbox Item                               .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I GET_STATUS_INFO               Get Text and Visualization for Status                       .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I READ_INBOX                    Read Inbox of Particular User                               .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I SCHEDULE_TASK                 Add Rescheduled Task                                        .
IF_FOPCW_WORKFLOW              I START_EXECUTION               Call upon Execution Start                                   .
IF_FOPC_ASSERT_HR_ORG_OBJECT   I ASSERT_HR_ORG_OBJECT          Assert HR Org Object                                        .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I DELETE                        Delete Cases and Workflows                                  .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I GET_CASE_BY_HR_NODE           Get cases for a given HR node                               .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I GET_HR_TREE_NODE_DETAIL       Get detail data for a tree node                             .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I GET_MAX_HR_ENTITY_ID          Method Returns Maximum HR Entity ID                         .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I GET_TOP_CASE_DETAIL           Get Detail of Case                                          .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I IS_CORRUPT                    Is the Case Corrupt?                                        .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I MODEL_UPDATE_VIEW             Simulate PBO Event                                          .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_HR_TREE_NODE_KEY          Set Node Key for an HR Entity                               .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_PARAMETER_COLLECTION      Set Parameter for Collection Method                         .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_PARAMETER_TIMEFRAME       Set Parameter for Timeframe and Year                        .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_RANGE_CATEGORY            Set Range for Category                                      .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_RANGE_CT                  Set Range for Creation Time                                 .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_RANGE_EXT_REF             Set Range for Case External Reference                       .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_RANGE_GUID                Set Range for Case GUID                                     .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SET_RANGE_TYPE                Set Range for Type                                          .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SHOW_TOP_CASE_DETAIL          Show Details of Top Case                                    .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I SHOW_TOP_CASE_LIST            Show List of Top Cases                                      .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I UPDATE_CASE_DELETION          Select/Deselect Case Row                                    .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I UPDATE_WF_DELETION            Update Deletion Indicator of Workflows                      .
IF_FOPC_AS_REORG_UI            I VIEW_UPDATE_MODEL             Simulate PAI Event                                          .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I CLONE                         Make Copy of Case Instance                                  .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I COLLECT_ALL                   Collect All Subcases                                        .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I DELETE                        Case: Delete                                                .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I DEQUEUE                       Remove Lock from Case                                       .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I DEQUEUE_ALL                   Dequeue Current Case and All its Subcases                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I ENQUEUE                       Lock Case                                                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I ENQUEUE_ALL                   Enqueue Current Case and All its Subcases                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_ACTIVITY_LIST             Transactions                                                .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_BACK_CASE_API             Get mo_fopc_case_api                                        .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CASE_CATEGORY             Category                                                    .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CASE_CATEGORY_TEXT        Category Text                                               .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CASE_GUID                 Technical Key of Case (Case GUID)                           .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CASE_TYPE                 Case Type                                                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CF_DESTINATION            Get Destination Where Case Is Carried Forward to            .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CF_SOURCE                 Get Source Case for Case Carried Forward                    .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CF_STATUS                 Get Carryforward Status                                     .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CF_STATUS_TEXT            Get Carryforward Status                                     .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_CREATOR                   Get Processor for the Case                                  .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_DATE_INTERVAL             Get Timeframe and Date Interval                             .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_HROBJECT                  HR-ORG To Which Case Is Attached                            .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_HR_ORG                    HR Org Unit To Which Case Is Attached                       .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_MIC_TASK_TYPE             Get Task Type                                               .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_PRIORITY_FOR_WORKFLOW     Get Priority for Workflow                                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_PROCESSOR                 Get Processor for the Case                                  .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Get Case Owner                                              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_RESPONSIBLE_AGENT         Get Permitted Processors for Workflow Use Only              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_STATUS                    Editing the Status                                          .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_STATUS_TEXT               Editing the Status                                          .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_TITLE                     Case Header                                                 .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_TRIGGERING_ASSESSMENT     Get Triggering Assessment or Testing Case                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_UI_ATTRIBUTE              Get All Attributes for UI                                   .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I GET_VALIDATION_COMMENT        Get Validation                                              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I IS_ENQUEUED                   Check Whether Case Is Enqueued                              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I IS_STATUS                     Check Whether Status Is Active                              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I IS_VALIDATION_ENABLED         Is Validation Enabled                                       .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_ACTIVITY                  Make Status Changes for a Transaction                       .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_CF_STATUS                 Get Carryforward Status                                     .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_CF_TIMEFRAME              Set Required Carryforward Attribute                         .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_CI_ATTRIBUTE              Set Customer Include Attribute                              .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_PROCESSOR                 Set Owner as Processor for the Case                         .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_RESPONSIBLE               Set Owner as Responsible for the Case                       .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_TITLE                     Case Header                                                 .
IF_FOPC_CASE                   I SET_VALIDATION_COMMENT        Validate                                                    .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I ADD_TEXT                      Get New Text                                                .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I CHANGE_LAST_TEXT              Offer Last Text for Changing                                .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I GET_CHANGED_PROT              Get Changed Log                                             .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I GET_LAST_TEXT                 Get Last Text                                               .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I GET_TEXTS                     Read Texts                                                  .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I IS_CHANGED                    Whether Case Notes Are Changed (X = yes, Space = no)        .
IF_FOPC_CASE_NOTES_API         I UNDO_TEXTS                    Remove Added Texts                                          .
IF_FOPC_CLS_CHANGE             I SET_STATUS                    Update Status                                               .
IF_FOPC_CLS_DISPLAY            I ASSERT_ALLOWED                Assert that Given Task Is Allowed                           .
IF_FOPC_CLS_DISPLAY            I SELECT_FROM_DB                Select Information from Database                            .
IF_FOPC_CLS_ENQUEUE            I DEQUEUE                       Unlock                                                      .
IF_FOPC_CLS_ENQUEUE            I ENQUEUE                       Lock                                                        .
IF_FOPC_DL_ACTOR_UI            I ACT_FOR                       Select Delegate Entry                                       .
IF_FOPC_DL_ACTOR_UI            I GET_LIST                      Return Current Setting                                      .
IF_FOPC_DL_DELEGATE            I GET_ACTING_PERSON             Get Person ID of the Acting User                            .
IF_FOPC_DL_DELEGATE            I GET_MAIN_PERSON               Get Person ID of the Main User                              .
IF_FOPC_DL_DELEGATE            I GET_NAME_AS_STRING            Get Name of Acting and Main User as String                  .
IF_FOPC_DL_DELEGATE            I IS_ON_MY_OWN_BEHALF           IS_ON_MY_OWN_BEHALF                                         .
IF_FOPC_DL_MAINTANANCE_UI      I DELETE                        Delete Entry from Database                                  .
IF_FOPC_DL_MAINTANANCE_UI      I GET_LIST                      Get All Delegate Entries                                    .
IF_FOPC_DL_MAINTANANCE_UI      I INSERT                        Insert Entry into Database                                  .
IF_FOPC_DL_MAINTANANCE_UI      I UPDATE                        Update an Entry. See INSERT                                 .
IF_FOPC_DL_STAMP               I SET_VALUE                     Set Value by Delegation Object                              .
IF_FOPC_IS_VALIDATION_ENABLED  I IS_VALIDATION_ENABLED_HROBJECTIs Validation Enabled for HR Object                         .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I DELETE                        Notes: Delete                                               .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I DEQUEUE                       Notes: Unlock                                               .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I ENQUEUE                       Notes: Lock                                                 .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I GET_CONTENT                   Get Contents of Notes                                       .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I GET_SRM_POID                  Get SRM_POID of the Note                                    .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I GET_UPDATE_TASK               Read Update Switch                                          .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I IS_CHANGED                    Whether Note is Changed (X/Space=Yes/No)                    .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I IS_ENQUEUED                   Whether Note is Enqueued (X/Space=Yes/No)                   .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I SAVE                          Notes: Save                                                 .
IF_FOPC_NOTES_API              I SET_CONTENT                   Set Note Contents                                           .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_CASE   I ACTIVATE                      Activate Replacement                                        .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_CASE   I GET_REQUEST_INFO              Get Attributes of Request                                   .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_CASE   I SET_NEW_PERSON                Set New Person Replacing Old Person                         .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_MASS   I DELETE_REQUEST                Delete Request after Transferring                           .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_MASS   I GET_REQUEST_CASE              Get Instance of Request                                     .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_MASS   I GET_REQUEST_ROLE              Get Instance of Request                                     .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_MASS   I GET_REQUEST_TYPE              Get Type of Replacement Request                             .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_ROLE   I ACTIVATE                      Trace On                                                    .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_ROLE   I GET_REQUEST_INFO              Get Request Attributes                                      .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_ROLE   I SET_NEW_PERSON                Set New Person Replacing Old Person                         .
IF_FOPC_REPLACEMENT_REQ_TESTER I SET_NEW_PERSON                Set New Person Replacing Old Person                         .
IF_FOPC_TESTER                 I GET_SLOT_BY_PERSON            Get Slot for Given Person                                   .
IF_FOPC_TESTER                 I GET_SLOT_TAB                  Get List of Slots                                           .
IF_FOPC_TESTER                 I GET_TESTER_INFO               Get Test Slot and Person                                    .
IF_FOPC_TESTER                 I GET_WF_AGENT                  Get Workflow Agent                                          .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_MASTER        I CHECK_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP         Read Active Tab Pages                                       .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_MASTER        I CHECK_ATTACHMENTS_TOOLBAR     Read Active Pushbuttons                                     .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_MASTER        I GET_RELATED_OBJECTS_KEYS      Returns Table of Parent Keys from an MIC PCUI Framework Key .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_SLAVE         I CHECK_SAVE                    Ask Slave if the SAVE Should Be Prevented                   .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_SLAVE         I GET_MESSAGES                  Read Error Messages                                         .
IF_FOPC_UI_PROXY_SLAVE         I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_LINKED_OBJECT_EXT         Object with Object Relationship in External Format          .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_LINK_TYPE_EXT             Object Relationship in External Format                      .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_OBJECT_DATA               Read Object Data                                            .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_OBJECT_EXT                Object in External Format                                   .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_OBJECT_KEY_EXT            Object Key in External Format                               .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_EXT           Object Type in External Format                              .
IF_FOX_BASIC_OBJECT            I SET_KEY_EXT                   Set External Object Key                                     .
IF_FOX_COMPONENT_PROVIDER      I GET_ALL_COMPONENTS            procures all dependent components                           .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I FIND_OBJECT                   Find Object                                                 .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_NUMBER_BY_TYPE            Stage Object Type and Number of Objects                     .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_OBJECTS_BY_TYPE           Stage All Objects for Type                                  .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_OBJECTS_TO_PARENT         Stage All Subordinate Objects                               .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_PARENTS_TO_OBJECT         Stage All Superior Objects                                  .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_STATISTIC                 Statistical Information for an Explosion                    .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_TOP_OBJECTS               Stage Top Objects                                           .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_TOTAL_STATISTIC           Statistical Information for the Entire FLOB                 .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I GET_VALIDITIES                Provide Validity Information                                .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I IS_TOP_OBJECT                 Is the Object a Top Object?                                 .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I SET_FOCUS                     Set Entire FLOB or New Top Object                           .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I UPDATE_DATA                   Refresh Data                                                .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I WHERE_USED                    Where-Used List for Top Objects                             .
IF_FOX_FLOB_SELECTOR           I WRITE_HIERARCHIE_AS_LIST      Output Hierarchy as List                                    .
IF_FOX_FLOB_USED               I IS_USED                       Is the FLOB Used?                                           .
IF_FOX_FLOB_USED               I WHERE_USED                    Where Is the FLOB Used?                                     .
IF_FOX_FREEABLE_OBJECT         I FREE_DATA                     Delete Data                                                 .
IF_FOX_MSG_PARAMETER           I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Parameters for Messages                                 .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_AS_KEY_VISITOR   I END_VISIT                     End of Visitor Iteration                                    .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_AS_KEY_VISITOR   I START_VISIT                   Start of Visitor Iteration                                  .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_AS_KEY_VISITOR   I VISIT_OBJECT                  Visitor Method for FOX Key                                  .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_STACK            I GET_OBJECT_STACK              Delivers the current object stack                           .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_VALIDITY         I GET_TYPE                      Return Validity Type                                        .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_VALIDITY         I SET_INVALID                   Flag Object as Invalid                                      .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_VISITOR          I END_VISIT                     End of Visitor Iteration                                    .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_VISITOR          I START_VISIT                   Start of Visitor Iteration                                  .
IF_FOX_OBJECT_VISITOR          I VISIT_OBJECT                  Visitor Method for a FOX Object                             .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I DELETE_FAILED                 Error While Deleting Data                                   .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I READ_FAILED                   Error Importing Data                                        .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I REQUEST_DELETE                Mark for deletion                                           .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I REQUEST_SAVE                  Mark for Saving                                             .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I TRIGGER_DELETE_START          Start Deletion Process                                      .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I TRIGGER_SAVE_START            Start Backup Process                                        .
IF_FOX_PERSISTENCE_CONTROLLER  I WRITE_FAILED                  Error While Exporting Data                                  .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I EVENT_RETURN_COMPONENTS       Return Dependent Objects from Event Registering             .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I FREE_DATA                     Delete Data and References                                  .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I GET_ALL_COMPONENTS            Return All Components at the Same Time                      .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I GET_ALL_COMPONENTS_BY_LINKTYPEReturn of All Dependent Objects for a Link Type             .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I REMOVE_OBJECT_DATA            Delete Object Data                                          .
IF_FOX_STRUCTURED_OBJECT       I SET_CONSTRUCTION_PARAMETERS   Enter the Necessary Parameter (such as Object Key)          .
IF_FOX_STRUCT_OBJECT_FACTORY   I ADD_ANCHOR                    Enter Anchor of Assigned Package                            .
IF_FOX_STRUCT_OBJECT_FACTORY   I CALLBACK_DONT_EXPLODE_OBJECT  Callback for Event OBJECT_CREATED: Do Not Explode Further   .
IF_FOX_STRUCT_OBJECT_FACTORY   I CALLBACK_OBJECT_NOT_RELEVANT  Callback for Event OBJECT_CREATED: Ignore                   .
IF_FOX_STRUCT_OBJECT_FACTORY   I CREATE_STRUCT_OBJECT          Create New Instance or Return Existing Instance If Found    .
IF_FOX_STRUCT_OBJECT_FACTORY   I OBJECT_STATE_CHANGED          Object Changed                                              .
IF_FOX_UI_SERVICE              I GET_LINKED_OBJECT             Object Input                                                .
IF_FOX_UI_SERVICE              I WRITE_VALIDITIES_AS_LIST      Output Validities as List                                   .
IF_FP                          I CREATE_ADS_OBJECT             Generates ADS Object                                        .
IF_FP                          I CREATE_PDF_OBJECT             Generates PDF Object                                        .
IF_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_ADD_CRITS     I GET_ADD_CRIT_FROM_OBJ         Object Type, Value -" add_crit                              .
IF_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_ADD_CRITS     I GET_ADD_CRIT_LIST             Gets List with Additional Criteria                          .
IF_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_ADD_CRITS     I MODIFY_REPORT_LIST            Change to the Report List                                   .
IF_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_SELPAR        I MODIFY_SELPAR                 Modification to the Selection Parameters                    .
IF_FPB_LAUNCHPAD_SELPARAM      I MODIFY_SELPARAM               Modification to the Selection Parameters                    .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FOR_LINEITEM  Authorization Check for Individual Line Item                .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FOR_RULE      Authorization Check for Rule                                .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I CONVERT_OBJECT_TO_EXT         Output Conversion of the Object                             .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I DELETE_ADMRULE                Application-Specific Deletion for an Administration Rule    .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I DELETE_RULE                   Application-Specific Deletion of a Rule                     .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I EVALUATE                      Evaluates All Rules for Users and Saves the Result          .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I GET_DETAIL                    Detail Display for a Line Item                              .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I GET_TEXT                      Text Determination for Front End                            .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I RESOLVE_KFSPECGL              Explode Characteristic KFSPECGL from Rule Field             .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I RESOLVE_OBJECT                Determine Object List from Object Entry in Rule             .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I RULE_INIT_DATA_GET            Initial Values Needed to Create New Rule                    .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I STORE_KFSPECGL                Save Characteristic KFSPECGL from Rule Field                .
IF_FPB_MON_LINE_APPL           I STORE_OBJECT                  Save Object List from Object Entry in Rule                  .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FOR_DATA      Authorization Check for Data                                .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FOR_RULE      Authorization Check for Rule                                .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I CONVERT_KFSPECGL_TO_EXT       Output Conversion of the Object                             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I CONVERT_OBJECT_TO_EXT         Output Conversion of the Object                             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I DELETE_ADMRULE                Delete Rule                                                 .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I DELETE_RULE                   Delete Rule                                                 .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I EVALUATE                      Evaluates All Rules for Users and Saves the Result          .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I GET_PERIOD_TEXTS              Application-Dependent Column Text                           .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I GET_PERSONALIZED_KFSPECGL     Explode Characteristic KFSPECGL from Rule Field             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I GET_PERSONALIZED_OBJECTS      Determine Object List from Object Entry in Rule             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I GET_TEXT                      Read Rule Type Dependent Texts for Variance Monitor         .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I RESOLVE_KFSPECGL              Explode Characteristic KFSPECGL from Rule Field             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I RESOLVE_OBJECT                Determine Object List from Object Entry in Rule             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I RULE_INIT_DATA_GET            Initial Data Needed to Create New Rule                      .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I STORE_KFSPECGL                Application-Specific Save of Multiple Selection             .
IF_FPB_MON_VAR_APPL            I STORE_OBJECT                  Application-Specific Save of Multiple Selection             .
IF_FPB_PERS_DYN_DIALOG_CHANGE  I CHANGE_TABLES                 Change to Field List                                        .
IF_FPB_PERS_EVALUATE_VARIABLE  I EVALUATE_VARIABLE             Variable Evaluation                                         .
IF_FPB_SNI_APPL                I SET_PERSDIALOG_USER           Dialog for Front-End Personalization                        .
IF_FPB_SNI_HIER                I CHECK_ACTIVE                  SNI: Check Whether Hierarchy is to be Displayed             .
IF_FPB_SNI_HIER                I GET_TOPOBJECTS                SNI: Determine the Objects on the First Hierarchy Level     .
IF_FPB_SNI_OBJECTS             I CONV_INT_TO_EXT               SNI. Conversion of Object Name to External Representation   .
IF_FPB_SNI_OBJECTS             I GET_DETAILS                   SNI: Check and Determine the Name of an Object              .
IF_FPB_SNI_OBJECTS             I GET_ICON                      SNI: Icon for Object Type in Hierarchy                      .
IF_FPB_SNI_OBJECTS             I GET_SEARCHFVAL                SNI: Determine Values of Search Criteria for Objects        .
IF_FPB_SNI_OBJECTS             I INIT                          SNI: Set Global Hierarchy Parameters                        .
IF_FPB_SNI_SUBOBJ              I GET_SUBOBJECTS                SNI: Determine the Direct Subnodes in Hierarchy             .
IF_FPB_SNI_SUBOBJ              I INIT                          SNI: Set Global Hierarchy Parameters                        .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_ADDRESS_LINES             Get Number of Rows                                          .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_ADDRESS_NUMBER            Get Address Number                                          .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_ADDRESS_TYPE              Get Address Type                                            .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_BUPA_ORG                  Business Partner Number for Organization; Get Company       .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_BUPA_PERSON               Get Business Partner Number for Person                      .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_BUPA_TIMESTAMP            Get Timestamp                                               .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_BUPA_TIME_DEPENDENT       Get Time-Dependent Business Partner Name                    .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_COUNTRY_NAME_IN_REC_LANG  Get Country Indicator in Recipient Language                 .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_LANGUAGE_FOR_COUNTRY      Get Language for Country Indicator                          .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_LINE_PRIORITY             Get Priority for Address Lines                              .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_NO_UPPERCASE              Get Upper-/Lowercase                                        .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_PERSON_ABOVE_ORGANIZATION Get Person Above Organization                               .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_PERSON_NUMBER             Get Person Number                                           .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_RECEIVER_LANGUAGE         Get Recipient Language                                      .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_SENDER_COUNTRY            Get Sending Country                                         .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I GET_STREET_PRIORITY           Get Priority of Street                                      .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_ADDRESS_LINES             Set Number of Lines                                         .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_ADDRESS_NUMBER            Set Address Number                                          .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_ADDRESS_TYPE              Set Address Type                                            .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_BUPA_ORG                  Business Partner Number for Organization; Set Company       .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_BUPA_PERSON               Set Business Partner Number for Person                      .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_BUPA_TIMESTAMP            Set Time Stamp                                              .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_BUPA_TIME_DEPENDENT       Set Time-Dependent Business Partner Name                    .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_COUNTRY_NAME_IN_REC_LANG  Set Country Indicator in Recipient Language                 .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_LANGUAGE_FOR_COUNTRY      Set Language for Country Indicator                          .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_LINE_PRIORITY             Set Priority for Address Lines                              .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_NO_UPPERCASE              Set Upper-/Lowercase                                        .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_PERSON_ABOVE_ORGANIZATION Set Person Above Organization                               .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_PERSON_NUMBER             Set Person Number                                           .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_RECEIVER_LANGUAGE         Set Recipient Language                                      .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_SENDER_COUNTRY            Set Sending Country                                         .
IF_FP_ADDRESS                  I SET_STREET_PRIORITY           Set Priority of Street                                      .
IF_FP_ADS_OBJECT               I RESET                         Initialize Object                                           .
IF_FP_ADS_OBJECT               I RUN                           Call ADS                                                    .
IF_FP_ADS_OBJECT               I SET_DATASET                   Set DATASET                                                 .
IF_FP_ALTERNATIVE              I GET_ALTERNATIVE_CONDITION     Get Alternative Condition                                   .
IF_FP_ALTERNATIVE              I GET_ALTERNATIVE_FALSE         Get Alternative (FALSE)                                     .
IF_FP_ALTERNATIVE              I GET_ALTERNATIVE_TRUE          Get Alternative (TRUE)                                      .
IF_FP_CHK                      I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_CHK                      I GET_GROUPS                    Get Groups                                                  .
IF_FP_CHK                      I GET_ITEMS                     Get Checks/Updates                                          .
IF_FP_CHK                      I GET_PARAMETER                 Get Parameters                                              .
IF_FP_CHK                      I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_FP_CHK                      I SET_PARAMETER                 Set Parameters                                              .
IF_FP_CHK                      I UPDATE                        Change                                                      .
IF_FP_CHK_GROUP                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_FP_CHK_GROUP                I GET_ID                        Get ID                                                      .
IF_FP_CHK_GROUP                I GET_ITEMS                     Get Checks/Updates                                          .
IF_FP_CHK_GROUP                I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_CHECK_ONLY                Check Only/No Update?                                       .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_GROUP                     Get Group                                                   .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_ID                        Get ID                                                      .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_LOGS                      Get Information                                             .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I GET_STATE                     Get Status                                                  .
IF_FP_CHK_ITEM                 I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_FP_CHK_LOG                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_FP_CHK_LOG                  I GET_ITEM                      Get Item                                                    .
IF_FP_CHK_LOG                  I GET_OBJECT                    Get Object                                                  .
IF_FP_CODING                   I GET_FORMS_CODING              Get Code for Form Routines                                  .
IF_FP_CODING                   I GET_INIT_CODING               Get Code for Initialization                                 .
IF_FP_CODING                   I GET_INIT_INPUT_PARAMS         Get Import Parameters for Initialization                    .
IF_FP_CODING                   I GET_INIT_OUTPUT_PARAMS        Get Export Parameters for Initialization                    .
IF_FP_CODING                   I SET_FORMS_CODING              Set Code for Form Routines                                  .
IF_FP_CODING                   I SET_INIT_CODING               Set Code for Initialization                                 .
IF_FP_CODING                   I SET_INIT_INPUT_PARAMS         Set Import Parameters for Initialization                    .
IF_FP_CODING                   I SET_INIT_OUTPUT_PARAMS        Set Export Parameters for Initialization                    .
IF_FP_COMMAND                  I GET_SPOOL_ATTRIBUTES          Get Spool Attributes                                        .
IF_FP_COMMAND                  I SET_SPOOL_ATTRIBUTES          Set Spool Attributes                                        .
IF_FP_CONDITION                I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_CONDITION                I GET_CONDITIONS                Get Conditions                                              .
IF_FP_CONDITION                I SET_CONDITIONS                Set conditions                                              .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_ADDRESS                Create Address                                              .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_ALTERNATIVE            Create procurement alternative                              .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_COMMAND                Create command                                              .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_DATA                   Create Data                                                 .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_FOLDER                 Create Folder                                               .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_GRAPHIC_CONTENT        Create Graphic Content                                      .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_GRAPHIC_URL            Create Graphic Reference                                    .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_LOOP                   Create Loop                                                 .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_PROGRAMLINES           Create Program Lines                                        .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_SINGLE_RECORD          Create Single Record                                        .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_STRUCTURE              Create Structure                                            .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_TEXT_BTF               Create BTF Text                                             .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_TEXT_DYNAMIC           Create Dynamic Text                                         .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_TEXT_INCLUDE           Create Include Text                                         .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I CREATE_TEXT_MODULE            Create Text Module                                          .
IF_FP_CONTEXT                  I GET_FORM                      Open form                                                   .
IF_FP_DATA                     I GET_FIELD                     Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_DATA                     I GET_FIELD_LABEL               Get Field Label                                             .
IF_FP_DATA                     I GET_FIELD_LABEL_TEXT          Get Field Label Text                                        .
IF_FP_DATA                     I REFRESH                       Update (Synchronize Node with ABAP Dictionary)              .
IF_FP_DATA                     I SET_FIELD                     Set Field                                                   .
IF_FP_DATA                     I SET_FIELD_LABEL               Set Field Label                                             .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I GET_INTERFACE_PARAMETERS      Get Interface Parameters                                    .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I PAI_LAYOUT                    Subscreen Layout                                            .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I PBO_CONTEXT                   Subscreen Context                                           .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I PBO_LAYOUT                    Subscreen Layout                                            .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I REPLACE_CONTEXT_TREE_NODE     Replace Node in Context Tree                                .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I UPDATE_CONTEXT_TABSTRIP       Update Tab Page: Context Properties                         .
IF_FP_FB_FORM                  I UPDATE_CONTEXT_TREE           Update Context Tree                                         .
IF_FP_FB_INTERFACE             I PBO_INTERFACE                 Subscreen Interface                                         .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I ACTIVATE                      Activate object                                             .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I CHANGE                        Change object                                               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I CHECK                         Check Object                                                .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I COPY                          Copy Object                                                 .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I CREATE                        Create Object                                               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I DELETE                        Delete Object                                               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I DISPLAY                       Display Object                                              .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I DISPLAY_VERSION               Display Version Object                                      .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I DOWNLOAD                      Download Object                                             .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I EXECUTE                       Execute Object (Test)                                       .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I GENERATE                      Generate Object                                             .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I GET_FORM_BUILDER              Get Form Builder                                            .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I GET_VERSION                   Get Version Number                                          .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I GET_WB_OBJECT                 Get Form Object (Workbench)                                 .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I HANDLE_MODIFICATIONS          Handle Changes                                              .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I NAVIGATE_TO                   Navigate to Object                                          .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_CONTROLS_MAIN             Controls: Main Screen                                       .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_CURSOR                    Get Cursor                                                  .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_CURSOR_MAIN               Get Cursor Main Screen                                      .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_EXIT_COMMAND_MAIN         Exit Command Main Screen                                    .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_PROPERTIES                Subscreen Properties                                        .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PAI_USER_COMMAND_MAIN         User Command Main Screen                                    .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PBO_CURSOR                    Set Cursor                                                  .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PBO_FORM_BUILDER              Form Builder Main Screen                                    .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PBO_PROPERTIES                Subscreen Properties                                        .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PBO_STATUS_MAIN               Status Main Screen                                          .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PBO_TABSTRIP_MAIN             Tabstrip Main Screen                                        .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I POH_OBJECT_NAME_MAIN          F1 Help: Object Name Main Screen                            .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I PREPARE_FOR_TERMINATION       Logical End for a Program (Save, Destroy....)               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I RENAME                        Rename Object                                               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I TOGGLE_DISPLAY_EDIT           Display "-" Change                                          .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I UPDATE_OBJECT_STATE           Update View of Form Object                                  .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I UPLOAD                        Upload Object                                               .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I VERSIONS                      Object version management                                   .
IF_FP_FB_OBJECT                I VERSION_CREATE                Create Version Object                                       .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_CONTEXT                   Get Context                                                 .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_FORM_TYPE                 Get Form Type                                               .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_INTERFACE                 Get Interface                                               .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_INTERFACE_LASTDATE        Get Interface Change Date                                   .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_INTERFACE_LASTTIME        Get Interface Time of Last Change                           .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_INTERFACE_NAME            Get Name of Interface                                       .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_INTERFACE_PARAMETERS      Get Interface Parameters                                    .
IF_FP_FORM                     I GET_LAYOUT                    Get Layout                                                  .
IF_FP_FORM                     I SET_INTERFACE_NAME            Set Name of Interface                                       .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I GET_FIELDSYMBOLS              Get Field Symbol Definitions                                .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I GET_GLOBAL_DATA               Get Global Data Definitions                                 .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I GET_TYPES                     Get Type Declarations                                       .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I SET_FIELDSYMBOLS              Set Field Symbol Definitions                                .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I SET_GLOBAL_DATA               Set Global Data Definitions                                 .
IF_FP_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS       I SET_TYPES                     Set Type Declarations                                       .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC                  I CHANGE_TYPE                   Change Type                                                 .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_CONTENT          I GET_GRAPHIC_FIELD             Get Graphic Field                                           .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_CONTENT          I GET_GRAPHIC_MIME              Get Graphic MIME Type                                       .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_CONTENT          I SET_GRAPHIC_FIELD             Set Graphic Field                                           .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_CONTENT          I SET_GRAPHIC_MIME              Set Graphic MIME Type                                       .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_URL              I GET_GRAPHIC_URL               Get Graphic URL                                             .
IF_FP_GRAPHIC_URL              I SET_GRAPHIC_URL               Set Graphic URL                                             .
IF_FP_INTERFACE                I GET_INTERFACE_DATA            Get Interface Data                                          .
IF_FP_INTERFACE                I GET_INTERFACE_TYPE            Get Interface Type                                          .
IF_FP_INTERFACE                I SET_INTERFACE_TYPE            Set Interface Type                                          .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_CODING                    Get Code                                                    .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_GLOBAL_DEFINITIONS        Get Global Definitions                                      .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_INTERFACE                 Get Interface                                               .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_PARAMETERS                Get Parameters                                              .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Get Reference Fields                                        .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_STANDARD_PARAMETERS       Get Standard Parameters                                     .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_SYSTEM_FIELDS             Get System Fields                                           .
IF_FP_INTERFACE_DATA           I GET_XSD_DEFINITIONS           Get XML Schema Definitions                                  .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I GET_CACHE_INFO                Get Cache Information                                       .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I GET_FORM                      Open form                                                   .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I GET_LAYOUT_DATA               Get Layout Data                                             .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I GET_LAYOUT_TYPE               Get Layout Type                                             .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I GET_TRANSLATION_TYPE          Get Translation Type                                        .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I SET_CACHE_INFO                Set Cache Information                                       .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I SET_LAYOUT_DATA               Set Layout Data                                             .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I SET_LAYOUT_TYPE               Set Layout Type                                             .
IF_FP_LAYOUT                   I SET_TRANSLATION_TYPE          Set Translation Type                                        .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_CONTROL_LEVEL             Get Control Level                                           .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_FIRST_LINE                Get First Line                                              .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_LAST_LINE                 Get Last Line                                               .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_LOOP_DATA                 Get Loop (Data)                                             .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_LOOP_INTO                 Get Assignment Type INTO                                    .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_SORTED                    Get "Sort Already Exists"                                   .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_TABLE_NAME                Get Table Name                                              .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_WHERE_CONDITION           Get Where Condition                                         .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I GET_WORK_AREA                 Get Work Area                                               .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I REFRESH                       Update (Synchronize Node with ABAP Dictionary)              .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_CONTROL_LEVEL             Set Control Level                                           .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_FIRST_LINE                Set First Row                                               .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_LAST_LINE                 Set Last Row                                                .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_LOOP_INTO                 Set Assignment Type INTO                                    .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_SORTED                    Set "Sort Already Exists"                                   .
IF_FP_LOOP                     I SET_WORK_AREA                 Set Work Area                                               .
IF_FP_NODE                     I APPEND_CHILD                  Add Lower-Level Node                                        .
IF_FP_NODE                     I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_NODE                     I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_CHILD                     Get Lower-Level Node                                        .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_CHILD_BY_NAME             Get Lower-Level Node By Name                                .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_CONDITION                 Get Condition                                               .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_CONTEXT                   Get Context                                                 .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_GENERATED                 Get "Node was Generated"                                    .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_ID                        Get ID                                                      .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_NAME                      Get name                                                    .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_NODE_BY_ID                Get Node According to ID                                    .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_PARENT                    Get Higher-Level Node                                       .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_PREDECESSOR               Set Predecessor Node                                        .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_STATE                     Get Status                                                  .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Get Subsequent Node                                         .
IF_FP_NODE                     I GET_TYPE                      Get Node Type                                               .
IF_FP_NODE                     I INSERT_CHILD                  Insert Lower-Level Node                                     .
IF_FP_NODE                     I REMOVE_CHILD                  Delete Lower-Level Node                                     .
IF_FP_NODE                     I REMOVE_NODE                   Delete Node(s)                                              .
IF_FP_NODE                     I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set Description                                             .
IF_FP_NODE                     I SET_NAME                      Set Name                                                    .
IF_FP_NODE                     I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_FP_OBJECT                   I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_OBJECT                   I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_FP_OBJECT                   I GET_LANGUAGE                  Get Language                                                .
IF_FP_OBJECT                   I GET_TYPE                      Get Object Type                                             .
IF_FP_OBJECT                   I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set Description                                             .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I GET_EXCEPTIONS                Get Exceptions                                              .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Get Export Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I GET_IMPORT_PARAMETERS         Get Import Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I GET_TABLE_PARAMETERS          Get Table Parameters                                        .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I SET_EXCEPTIONS                Set Exceptions                                              .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I SET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Set Export Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I SET_IMPORT_PARAMETERS         Set Import Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_PARAMETERS               I SET_TABLE_PARAMETERS          Set Table Parameters                                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I EXECUTE                       Call ADS                                                    .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_ANNOTATIONS               Get Comments                                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_ATTACHMENTS               Get Attachments                                             .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_CACHE_INFO                Get Cache Information                                       .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_CERTIFICATION             Certification, Get Information                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_COPYTEMPLATE              Get Copy from Template                                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_DATA                      Extract form data                                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_DIFFERENCES               Extract Differences Between Versions                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_DOCUMENT                  Get PDF Document                                            .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_HASHEDTEMPLATE            Internal usage                                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_LEGALWARNINGS             Get Warnings                                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_PDF                       Get PDF (Only After Render Call); Otherwise GET_DOCUMENT    .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_PDL                       Get PDL                                                     .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_REVIEW_COPY               Get Copy for Review                                         .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_SCHEMA                    Get Schema from Template                                    .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_SIGNATURES                Get Signatures                                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_TRACE                     Read ADS Trace                                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_UPDATEDTEMPLATE           Get Updated Template                                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_UPDATES                   Get List of Template Updates                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I GET_VERSION_INFO              Get Version Information                                     .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I IS_SSL                        Query SSL Connection                                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I RESET                         Reset object                                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_ADS_TRACE                 Activate/Deactivate ADS Trace                               .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_ANNOTATIONS               Set Comments                                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_APPLICATION_FORM_IDENTITY Get Application and Form Identity                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_ATTACHMENTS               Set Attachments                                             .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_CERTIFICATION             Certification                                               .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_DATA                      Determine Data                                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_DOCUMENT                  Determine PDF Document                                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_EXTRACTDATA               Obsolete: -" SET_TASK_EXTRACTDATA                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_FONT_MAPPING              Get Font Mapping                                            .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_INITIAL_VIEW              Define Initial Display for PDF                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_METADATA                  Set Meta Data                                               .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_OUTPUTCONVERT             Obsolete: -" SET_TASK_CONVERTPDF2PDL                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_OUTPUTPDF                 Obsolete: -" SET_TASK_RENDERPDF                             .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_OUTPUTPDL                 Obsolete: -" SET_TASK_RENDERPDL                             .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_SIGNATURE                 Set Signature                                               .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_CALCULATE_HASHES     Internal usage                                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_CONVERTPDF2PDL       Determine Conversion from PDF to PDL                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_COPYTEMPLATE         Selection for Template Copy (New GUID)                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_CREATE_REVIEWCOPY    Selection for Review Copy                                   .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_EXTRACTCOLWIDTHS     Get Column Widths                                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_EXTRACTDATA          Select Data Extraction                                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETANNOTATIONS       Extract Selection for Comments                              .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETATTACHMENTS       Get Selection for Attachments                               .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETCACHEINFO         Get Cache Information                                       .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETCERTIFICATION     Select Get Certificate                                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETDIFFERENCES       Select Difference Determination                             .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETLEGALWARNINGS     Get Warnings                                                .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETSCHEMA            Select Schema Determination from Template                   .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_GETSIGNATURES        Select Get Signature                                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_RENDERPDF            Select PDF Output                                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_RENDERPDL            Select PDL Output                                           .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TASK_UPDATETEMPLATE       Select Template Update                                      .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TEMPLATE                  Determine Template                                          .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_TEMPLATEBATCHINFO         Set Template Information for Bundling                       .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_UPDATES                   Set Template Updates                                        .
IF_FP_PDF_OBJECT               I SET_USAGERIGHTS               Set Usage Rights                                            .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I GET_CODING                    Get Code                                                    .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I GET_INPUT_PARAMETERS          Get Input Parameters                                        .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I GET_OUTPUT_PARAMETERS         Get Output Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I SET_CODING                    Set Code                                                    .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I SET_INPUT_PARAMETERS          Set Input Parameters                                        .
IF_FP_PROGRAMLINES             I SET_OUTPUT_PARAMETERS         Set Output Parameters                                       .
IF_FP_REFERENCE_FIELDS         I GET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Get Reference Fields                                        .
IF_FP_REFERENCE_FIELDS         I SET_REFERENCE_FIELDS          Set Reference Fields                                        .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I GET_BINARY_SEARCH             Get Binary Search                                           .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I GET_LINE                      Get Line                                                    .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I GET_TABLE_NAME                Get Table Name                                              .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I GET_WITH_KEY_CONDITION        Get With Key Condition                                      .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I REFRESH                       Update (Synchronize Node with ABAP Dictionary)              .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I SET_BINARY_SEARCH             Set Binary Search                                           .
IF_FP_SINGLE_RECORD            I SET_LINE                      Set Line                                                    .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I APPEND_CHILD                  Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I CHECK                         Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I COPY                          Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_CHILD                     Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_CONDITION                 Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_CONTEXT                   Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_FIELD                     Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_ID                        Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_NAME                      Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_NODE_BY_ID                Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_PARENT                    Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_PREDECESSOR               Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I GET_TYPE                      Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I INSERT_CHILD                  Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I REFRESH                       Update (Synchronize Node with ABAP Dictionary)              .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I REMOVE_CHILD                  Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I REMOVE_NODE                   Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I SET_DESCRIPTION               Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_STRUCTURE                I SET_NAME                      Get Field                                                   .
IF_FP_SYSTEM_FIELDS            I GET_SYSTEM_DATA               Get System Data                                             .
IF_FP_TEXT                     I CHANGE_TYPE                   Change Type                                                 .
IF_FP_TEXT                     I GET_APPEND_MODE               Get Append Mode                                             .
IF_FP_TEXT                     I SET_APPEND_MODE               Set Append Mode                                             .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I GET_STYLE_NAME                Get Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I GET_TEXT_FIELD                Get Text Field                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I GET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Get Text Language                                           .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I SET_STYLE_NAME                Set Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I SET_TEXT_FIELD                Set Text Field                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_DYNAMIC             I SET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Set language for text                                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_DEFAULT_PARAGRAPH         Get Standard Paragraph                                      .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_FIRST_PARAGRAPH           Get First Paragraph                                         .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_IGNORE_ERROR              Get Flag (no error if no text exists)                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_STYLE_NAME                Get Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_TEXT_ID                   Get Text ID                                                 .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Get Text Language                                           .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_TEXT_NAME                 Get Text Name                                               .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I GET_TEXT_OBJECT               Get Text Object                                             .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_DEFAULT_PARAGRAPH         Set Standard Paragraph                                      .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_FIRST_PARAGRAPH           Set First Paragraph                                         .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_IGNORE_ERROR              Set Flag (no error if no text exists)                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_STYLE_NAME                Set Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_TEXT_ID                   Set Text ID                                                 .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Set language for text                                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_TEXT_NAME                 Set Text Name                                               .
IF_FP_TEXT_INCLUDE             I SET_TEXT_OBJECT               Set Text Object                                             .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I GET_IGNORE_ERROR              Get Flag (no error if no text exists)                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I GET_STYLE_NAME                Get Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I GET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Get Text Language                                           .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I GET_TEXT_NAME                 Get Text Name                                               .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I GET_TEXT_STYLE                Get Flag (Copy Style from Text Module)                      .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I SET_IGNORE_ERROR              Set Flag (no error if no text exists)                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I SET_STYLE_NAME                Set Style Name                                              .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I SET_TEXT_LANGUAGE             Set language for text                                       .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I SET_TEXT_NAME                 Set Text Name                                               .
IF_FP_TEXT_MODULE              I SET_TEXT_STYLE                Set Flag (Copy Style from Text Module)                      .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I FREE                          Release                                                     .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GENERATE                      Generate                                                    .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_CHANGED                   Get Change Status                                           .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_DEVCLASS                  Get Package                                                 .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_DOCU_ID                   Get Document Class                                          .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_FIRSTDATE                 Get Creation Date                                           .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_FIRSTTIME                 Get Creation Time                                           .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_FIRSTUSER                 Get User Name of "Created By"                               .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_LASTDATE                  Get Change Date                                             .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_LASTTIME                  Get Time of Last Change                                     .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_LASTUSER                  Get User Name of "Last Changed By"                          .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_MASTER_LANGUAGE           Get Original Language                                       .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_MODE                      Get Mode                                                    .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_MODIFICATION_LANGUAGE     Get Change Language                                         .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_NAME                      Get name                                                    .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_OBJECT                    Get Object                                                  .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_ORDERNUM                  Get Request                                                 .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_STATE                     Get Status                                                  .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I GET_TYPE                      Get Object Type (Workbench)                                 .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I RENAME                        Rename                                                      .
IF_FP_WB_OBJECT                I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_FP_XSD_DEFINITIONS          I GET_XSD_DATA                  Get XML Schema Data                                         .
IF_FP_XSD_DEFINITIONS          I GET_XSD_SOURCE                Get XML Schema Source                                       .
IF_FP_XSD_DEFINITIONS          I SET_XSD_DATA                  Set XML Schema Data                                         .
IF_FP_XSD_DEFINITIONS          I SET_XSD_SOURCE                Set XML Schema Source                                       .
IF_FRM377                      I FILTER_FORMULAS               Filtering the Formulas Found                                .
IF_FRM377                      I READ_ADDITIONAL_DATA          Read Other Formula Data                                     .
IF_FRM377                      I READ_FORMULAS_MANY            Mass Reading of Formulas                                    .
IF_FRM377                      I READ_HEADER                   Read Header Data                                            .
IF_FRM377                      I READ_SUBSTANCES               Read Input Substances                                       .
IF_FRML_CALC_IO_FIELDS         I CALC_FIELD                    Calculates One Field from Another (Such As Mass -" Volume)  .
IF_FRML_STD_CALC               I CALC_COMP_DATA                Calculate Nutrient Composition                              .
IF_FRML_STD_CALC               I GET_ALL_DATASRC               Get All Data Sources                                        .
IF_FRML_STD_CALC               I GET_COMP_DATA                 Get Nutrient Composition for Ingredients                    .
IF_FRML_STD_CALC               I GET_LAYGRP_MEMB               Get All Nutrients from All Nutrient Groups                  .
IF_FRML_STD_CALC               I INIT_CALC                     Initialize Calculation Object                               .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I GET_CC_TABLE_DATA             Returns Company-Code Dependent Data                         .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I GET_CC_TABLE_DATA_NEW         Supplies Current Status of Company-Code Dependent Data      .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I GET_CC_TABLE_DATA_OLD         Supplies Previous Status of Company-Code Dependent Data     .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I GET_COMPANY_CODES             Returns Company Codes (Reference)                           .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I SET_CC_TABLE_DATA_NEW         Sets New Company-Code Dependent Data                        .
IF_FSBP_AO_COMPANY_CODE        I VALIDATE_CC_DATA              Checks Data for Selected Company-Code                       .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I GET_DATA                      Returns Data                                                .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I GET_MY_NAME                   Returns Name of Application Object                          .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I GET_PARTNER                   Returns Partner Numbers                                     .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I GET_TABLE_OBJECT              Returns Reference to Object Dealing With Table              .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I GET_USED_TABLES               Returns List of Tables Used                                 .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I IS_DATA_MODIFIED              Checks Whether Data for Object Has Changed                  .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I IS_PARTNER_ID_TEMPORARY       Indicates Whether Partner Number Is Temporary               .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I IS_TABLE_USED                 Checks Whether Table Is Used in Application Object          .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I RESET                         Resets Object to Initial Status                             .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I SAVE_DATA                     Prompts Update of Data                                      .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I UPDATE_TEMP_PARTNER           Replaces Temporary Partner Number in Memory                 .
IF_FSBP_APPLICATION_OBJECT     I VALIDATE                      Starts Object Validation                                    .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_APPLICATION_DATA          Returns Data for Application Objects                        .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_APPLICATION_OBJECT        Returns Reference to Application Object                     .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_BPKIND                    Returns Business Partner Type                               .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_GENERAL_DATA              Returns General Data for Business Partner                   .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_GROUPING                  Returns Business Partner Grouping                           .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_MY_NAME                   Returns Name of Business Object                             .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_PARTNER                   Returns Partner Numbers                                     .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_ROLES                     Returns Roles for Business Partner                          .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_TABLE_DATA                Returns Data from Database Table                            .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_TYPE                      Returns Business Partner Category                           .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I GET_USED_APPLICATIONS         Returns List of Applications Used                           .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I HAS_ROLES                     Indicates Whether Partner Has This Role                     .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I IS_APPLICATION_USED           Checks Whether Application Object Is Used                   .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I IS_DATA_MODIFIED              Checks Whether Data for Object Has Changed                  .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I IS_PARTNER_ID_TEMPORARY       Indicates Whether Partner Number Is Temporary               .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I IS_PARTNER_NEW                Indicates Whether Partner Is Created                        .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I RESET                         Resets Object to Initial Status                             .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I SAVE_DATA                     Prompts Update of Data                                      .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I UPDATE_RELEASE_STATE          Changes Release Status for Business Partner                 .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I UPDATE_TEMP_PARTNER           Replaces Temporary Partner Number in Memory                 .
IF_FSBP_BUSINESS_OBJECT        I VALIDATE                      Starts Object Validation                                    .
IF_FSBP_CREDT_STANDNG_GET_BAPI I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          TransferExtensionOut                                        .
IF_FSBP_CREDT_STANDNG_SET_BAPI I TRANSFEREXTENSIONIN           TransferExtensionIn                                         .
IF_FSBP_CREDT_STANDNG_SET_BAPI I TRANSFEREXTENSIONOUT          TransferExtensionOut                                        .
IF_FSBP_CREDT_STANDNG_SET_BAPI I VALIDATEEXTENSIONIN           ValidateExtensionIn                                         .
IF_FSBP_DELETE_IDENTC_ALIAS    I DELETE_IDENTIC_ALIAS          Deletes Identical Aliases                                   .
IF_FSBP_LISTENER_OBJECT        I LISTEN                        Listener Object Is Requested to Participate                 .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I GET_DATA                      Returns New and Old Stock of Data                           .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I GET_DATA_NEW                  Returns Changed Data                                        .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I GET_DATA_OLD                  Returns Read Data                                           .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I GET_PARTNER                   Returns Partner Numbers                                     .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I GET_TABLE_NAME                Returns Name of Table                                       .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I IS_DATA_MODIFIED              Indicates Whether Data Has Changed                          .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I IS_DATA_READ                  Indicates Whether Database Has Read Data                    .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I IS_PARTNER_ID_TEMPORARY       Indicates Whether Partner Number Is Temporary               .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I RESET                         Resets Object to Initial Status                             .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I SAVE_DATA                     Prompts Save of Data to Database                            .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I SET_DATA_NEW                  Stores New/Changed Data in Memory                           .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I UPDATE_TEMP_PARTNER           Replaces Partner Number in Memory                           .
IF_FSBP_MEMORY_OBJECT          I VALIDATE                      Starts Validation for Memory Object                         .
IF_FSBP_MO_COMPANY_CODE        I VALIDATE_CC_DATA              Checks Data for Company Code                                .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I READ_DATA                     Reads Data for a Partner Table from the Database            .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I READ_DATA_SORTED_BY_PARTNER   Reads Data for Table Sorted According to Partner            .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I READ_DATA_WITH_KEY            Reads Data for a Partner Table with Key                     .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I SAVE_DATA                     Transfers Data to the Update Memory                         .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I SAVE_DATA_ENTRIES             Transfers the Transferred INSERT-, UPDATE and DELETE-Data   .
IF_FSBP_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT     I SORT_DATA_BY_PARTNER          Sorts Data for a Table According to Partner                 .
IF_FSBP_VALIDATION_OBJECT      I REGISTER_HANDLER              Registers Itself For the Event of a Validation Target Object.
IF_FSBP_VALIDATION_TARGET      I ADD_VALIDATION_RESULT         Adds Check Results                                          .
IF_FSBP_VALIDATION_TARGET      I GET_VALIDATION_RESULTS        Returns All Valid Check Results                             .
IF_FSCD_IO_ITEM_SEL            I FILTER_ITEMS                  Filter Items                                                .
IF_FTBB_MERITFUNCTION          I CALCULATE_CHI                 Calculation of Merit Function (Chi-Squared)                 .
IF_FTBB_MERITFUNCTION          I CALCULATE_CHI_AND_DERIVATIVES Calculation of Merit Function and Its 1st + 2nd Derivations .
IF_FTR_BAPI_CONDITIONS         I GET_CONDITIONS                Get Conditions from the Application                         .
IF_FTR_BAPI_CONDITIONS         I GET_CONTROLINFO               Get Control Information from the Application                .
IF_FTR_BAPI_CONDITIONS         I SET_CONDITIONS                Return Conditions to the Application                        .
IF_FTR_BAPI_FLOWS              I GET_GUI_FLOWS                 Determines Reference to GUI for Flows (Context)             .
IF_FTR_BAPI_PLUGIN_IRATE       I CHANGE                        Change Interest Rate Instrument                             .
IF_FTR_BAPI_PLUGIN_IRATE       I CREATE                        Create Interest Rate Instrument                             .
IF_FTR_BAPI_PLUGIN_IRATE       I GETDETAIL                     Read Interest Rate Instrument                               .
IF_FTR_BAPI_PLUGIN_IRATE       I REVERSE                       Reverse Interest Rate Instrument                            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_PLUGIN_IRATE       I SETTLE                        Settle Interest Rate Instrument                             .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I CHECK                         Check Transaction                                           .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I EXIT                          Leave Transaction Without Saving                            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I INIT                          Initialize Application for Existing Transactions            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I OKCODE                        Process the OK Code                                         .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I PAI_AFTER                     Actions after Calling Subscreen for PAI                     .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I PAI_BEFORE                    Actions before Calling Subscreen for PAI                    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I PBO_AFTER                     Actions after Calling Subscreen for PBO                     .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I PBO_BEFORE                    Actions before Calling Subscreens for PBO                   .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM               I SAVE                          Save Transaction                                            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_200           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_200           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_200           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_510           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_510           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating a Fixed-Term Deposit        .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_510           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_520           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_520           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating a Deposit at Notice         .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_520           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_530           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_530           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating a Commercial Paper          .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_530           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_540           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_540           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating a Cash Flow Transaction     .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_540           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_550           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_550           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_550           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600SWAP       I CREATE_2ND_DEAL               Method for Creating 2nd Forex Transaction for a Swap        .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600SWAP       I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600SWAP       I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_600SWAP       I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_6XX           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_6XX           I INIT_CREATE                   Import Parameter for Generating an OTC Interest Derivative  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_6XX           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_700           I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_700           I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_700           I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_760FX         I GET_BASIC_DATA                Return Application-Specific Structure Data                  .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_760FX         I INIT_CREATE                   Inbound Parameters for Creating Interest Rate Instrument    .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_760FX         I SET_BASIC_DATA                Application-Specific Structure Data for Checking            .
IF_FTR_BAPI_TRTM_760FX         I SET_CASH_DATA                 Set Cash Settlement in Case of Exercise                     .
IF_FTR_CF_CALCULATOR           I CALCULATE                     Calculates Financial Mathematical Cash Flow                 .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I COND_CHECK_AFTER              Check Condition                                             .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I COND_PROPOSE_BEFORE           Enhance Condition                                           .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOWAMOUNT_CHECK_AFTER        Check Flow Amount                                           .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOWCURRENCY_CHECK_AFTER      Check Flow Type                                             .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOWDATE_CHECK_AFTER          Check Flow Date                                             .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOWTYPE_CHECK_AFTER          Check Flow Direction                                        .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOW_CHECK_AFTER              Check Flow                                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_CHECKER              I FLOW_PROPOSE_BEFORE           Enhance Flow                                                .
IF_FTR_CF_DATA                 I CLONE                         Clone Data                                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I F4_CONDTYPE                   Volume of Permitted Condition Types                         .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I F4_IRATE_STRUCTURE            Volume of Permitted Values for Interest Form                .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATEADJ_FIT                  Adjustment of Conditions for Interest Rate Adjustment       .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATECOND_GET                 Determine Interest Structure                                .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_DELETE                  Delete Interest Structure                                   .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_EDIT                    Change Interest Structure                                   .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_GET                     Determine Interest Structure                                .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_INIT                    Set Parameters for Interest Adapter                         .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_PROPOSE                 Determine Default Values for Interest Structure             .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IRATE_TRANSLATE               Translates a Condition in Interest Structure                .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IS_IRATECAP_ACTIVE            Determines if Interest Capitalization Is Possible           .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IS_IRATE_ACTIVE               Determines if Nominal Interest Is Available                 .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IS_IRATE_DELETEABLE           Determines if Deletion Is Possible                          .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IS_IRATE_EDITABLE             Determines if Editing Is Possible                           .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I IS_RHYTHM_EDITABLE            Determines if Frequency Can Be Changed                      .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I PLUGINS_SET                   Set Plugins                                                 .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE                I TAB_IRATE_PARA_PROPOSE        Determines a Proposal for Setting Parameters                .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE_CHECKER        I IRATE_CHECK_AFTER             Check Interest Structure                                    .
IF_FTR_CF_IRATE_CHECKER        I IRATE_PROPOSE_BEFORE          Enhance Interest Structure                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I F4_NOMFLOW_TYPE               Volume of Permitted Values for Flow Types                   .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I IS_NOMFLOW_EDITABLE           Determines if Editing is Possible                           .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I NOMFLOW_EDIT                  Change Nominal Flow                                         .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I NOMFLOW_GET                   Determine Nominal Flow                                      .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I NOMFLOW_INIT                  Set Parameters for Adapter                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I NOMFLOW_PROPOSE               Proposal for Predefining Values                             .
IF_FTR_CF_NOMFLOW              I NOMFLOW_TRANSLATE             Determine Nominal Flow                                      .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I F4_CONDTYPE                   Volume of Permitted Condition Types                         .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I F4_REPAYM_STRUCTURE           Volume of Permitted Values for Repayment Form               .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I F4_RHYTHM                     Volume of Permitted Frequency Entries                       .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I IS_REPAYM_EDITABLE            Determines if Editing is Possible                           .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I IS_RHYTHM_EDITABLE            Determines if Frequency Entries can be Changed              .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I PLUGINS_SET                   Set Plug-ins for Repayment Adapter                          .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYMCOND_GET                Determine Repayment Structure                               .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYM_EDIT                   Change Repayment Structure                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYM_GET                    Determine Repayment Structure                               .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYM_INIT                   Set Parameters for Adapter                                  .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYM_PROPOSE                Determines a Proposal for Predefining Values                .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I REPAYM_TRANSLATE              Determine Repayment Structure                               .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM               I TAB_REPAYM_PARA_PROPOSE       Determines a Proposal for Setting Parameters                .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM_CHECKER       I REPAYM_CHECK_AFTER            Check Repayment Structure                                   .
IF_FTR_CF_REPAYM_CHECKER       I REPAYM_PROPOSE_BEFORE         Enhance Repayment Structure                                 .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I ASGN_DO                       Assign Drawing Object                                       .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I ASGN_RENAME                   Key Change of Drawing Object                                .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I ASGN_UNDO                     Delete Assignment of Drawing Object                         .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I ASGN_UPDATE                   Assign Drawing Object                                       .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I CHECK                         Complete Check of Facility                                  .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I CLOSE                         Close Facility without Saving (Lock Release)                .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I GET                           Determine Transaction Data of Facility                      .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I IS_TAB_POSITION_CHANGED       Check the Assignment Flow for Changes                       .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I IS_TAB_POS_OBJ_CHANGED        Check Assignment Object for Changes                         .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I SAVE                          Save Facility                                               .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I START                         Load Facility from Database                                 .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN                 I _IREF_RULESET_GET             Determine Conformity Management                             .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I ASGN_DO                       Assign Financial Transaction                                .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I ASGN_UNDO                     Delete Assignment of Financial Transaction                  .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I ASGN_UPDATE                   Update a Drawing Object                                     .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I CHECK                         Complete Check During Processing                            .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I DISPLAY                       Display Current Facility                                    .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I IS_ASGN                       Is the Financial Transaction Assigned to a Facility?        .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_FTR_FC_ASGN_TRTM            I SAVE_REQUIRED                 Save Necessary?                                             .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I COLLECT                       Collect GUI Data in Following Subscreen                     .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I DISPLAY                       Display GUI Data in Following Subscreen                     .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I FREE                          Class Destructor                                            .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I GET_REQUIRED_FIELDS           Determine Unprocessed Required Fields                       .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I HANDLE_OKCODE                 OK Code Handling in GUI                                     .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I SET_FIELDMOD                  Set GUI Field Modification                                  .
IF_FTR_GUI_APPL                I SET_MSG                       Set GUI Message                                             .
IF_FTR_GUI_CASHFLOW_APPL       I SET_CONTROLDATA               Set Control Data from Application                           .
IF_FTR_GUI_CONTRACT_APPL       I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_CONTRACT_APPL2      I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_DATABIN             I SET_FHA_RCOMVALCL             General Transaction Data: Set Valuation Class               .
IF_FTR_GUI_ENTRY_APPL          I SET_CONTEXT                   Set Context                                                 .
IF_FTR_GUI_ENTRY_APPL          I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_FLOWS_APPL          I GET_TAB_FHAPO_DELETED         Get Deleted Flow Records                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_FLOWS_APPL          I GET_TAB_FHAPO_MODIFIED        Get Modified Flow Records                                   .
IF_FTR_GUI_FLOWS_APPL          I GET_TAB_FHAPO_NEW             Get New Flow Records                                        .
IF_FTR_GUI_FLOWS_APPL          I GET_TAB_FHAPO_SELECTED        Get Selected Flow Records                                   .
IF_FTR_GUI_FLOWS_APPL          I SET_CONTROLDATA               Set Control Data from Application                           .
IF_FTR_GUI_FOREIGN_APPL        I APPLY_FMOD                    Execute Field Modification                                  .
IF_FTR_GUI_FOREIGN_APPL        I APPLY_FMOD_TC                 Execute Field Modification for Table Control                .
IF_FTR_GUI_FOREIGN_APPL        I MODIFY_SCREEN_ATTRIBUTES      Determine Screen Attributes acc. to Combination Logic       .
IF_FTR_GUI_FOREIGN_APPL        I SET_GUI                       Set Repid and Screen Number of Foreign GUI                  .
IF_FTR_GUI_HEADER_APPL         I GET_DISPLAYDATA               Read Display Data                                           .
IF_FTR_GUI_HEADER_APPL         I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_PARTNER_APPL        I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_PAYDET_APPL         I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_RATING_APPL         I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_STATUS_APPL         I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_GUI_TERM_APPL           I SET_DISPLAYDATA               Set Data to be Displayed                                    .
IF_FTR_HISTORY                 I HANDLE_DOUBLE_CLICK           Double-Click an Activity in the History                     .
IF_FTR_HISTORY                 I HANDLE_OKCODE                 User Command                                                .
IF_FTR_HISTORY                 I HANDLE_PF_STATUS              Set PF Status                                               .
IF_FTR_HISTORY                 I TAB_HISTORY_SELECT            Read Historical Data from Database                          .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I APPLICATION_START             TR Transaction Management is Instantiated                   .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I IS_OKCODE                     Is this an OK Code of Open TRTM                             .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I SET_PROXY_EDITMODE            Transfer Tabstrip Attributes to FMOD Proxy                  .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_CHECK             Explicit Transaction Check by User                          .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_FCODE             Time Before Change in GUI to FO Screen Takes Place          .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_FCODE_EXECUTE     Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_SAVE_CANCEL       Saving Cancelled                                            .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_SAVE_CHECK        Time for Checks Before DB Update Takes Place                .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_SAVE_READY        Transaction Management Ready to be Saved                    .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_SAVE_REQUIRED     Time to Specify Whether Changes must be Saved               .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM               I TRANSACTION_SET_DATA          Transfer Data for Enhancement in BAPI                       .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_BADI_BAV_ON               Switch BAV BAdI On/Off                                      .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_BADI_CUSTOM_ON            Switch Customer Enhancement On/Off                          .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_BADI_FO_ON                Switch Finance Object BAdI On/Off                           .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_BADI_HEDGE_MGMT_ON        Switch Hedge Management BAdIs On/Off                        .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_BADI_PA_ON                Switch Partner Assignment BAdIs On/Off                      .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_CUST_DATA                 Set Customer Data in VTBFHA                                 .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_DISTRIBUTOR_ON            Switch Distributor BAdI On/Off                              .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_FACILITY_ON               Switch Facility BAdI On/Off                                 .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_GENERIC_ON                Switch Generic BAdI On/Off                                  .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_MIRROR_ON                 Switch Mirror Transaction BAdI On/Off                       .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_SERVER_APPLICATION        Switch Open TRTM BAdI On/Off in Server Mode                 .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Sets Transaction Data                                       .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_CTRL          I SWITCH_OPEN_TRTM_ON           Switch Open TRTM On/Off                                     .
IF_FTR_OPEN_TRTM_XDATA         I SET_TRANSACTION_DATA          Give Transaction Data to Open TRTM                          .
IF_FTR_POSOBJ_MGR              I DISPLAY                       Display Drawing Object                                      .
IF_FTR_RULESET_GUI             I COLLECT                       Collect Data                                                .
IF_FTR_RULESET_GUI             I DISPLAY                       Display Data                                                .
IF_FTR_RULESET_GUI             I DISPLAY_FREE                  Exit Display                                                .
IF_FTR_RULESET_GUI             I DISPLAY_INIT                  Display for First Time                                      .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_ADD                        Add Rule for Company Code                                   .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_ALL                        Permit All Company Codes                                    .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_DELETE                     Delete a Rule for Company Code                              .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_GET                        Determine Rules for Company Code                            .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_ISMODIFIABLE               Possible to Change a Rule for Company Code                  .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CC_MODIFY                     Change a Rule for Company Code                              .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_ADD                        Add a Rule for Transaction Management                       .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_ALL                        Permit All Currencies                                       .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_DELETE                     Delete a Rule for Transaction Management                    .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_GET                        Determine Rules for Transaction Management                  .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_ISMODIFIABLE               Possible to Change a Rule for Transaction Management        .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I CR_MODIFY                     Change a Rule for Transaction Currency                      .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_ADD                        Add a Rule for Business Partner                             .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_ALL                        Permit All Partners                                         .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_DELETE                     Delete a Rule for Business Partner                          .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_F4                         F4 Help for Business Partner                                .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_GET                        Determine Rules for Business Partner                        .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_ISMODIFIABLE               Possible to Change a Rule for Business Partner              .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I PA_MODIFY                     Change a Rule for Business Partner                          .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I RULESET_APPLY                 Apply Rules to a Financial Transaction                      .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I RULESET_CHECK                 Check Rules (Memory Consistency)                            .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I RULESET_GET                   Determine Rules                                             .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I RULESET_LOAD                  Load Rules from Database                                    .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I RULESET_SAVE                  Save Rules                                                  .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TERM_DELETE                   Delete Term Restriction                                     .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TERM_GET                      Read Term Restriction                                       .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TERM_SET                      Set Term Restriction                                        .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_ADD                        Add a Rule for Transaction Type                             .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_ALL                        Permit All Transaction Types                                .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_DELETE                     Add a Rule for Transaction Type                             .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_GET                        Determine Rules for Transaction Type                        .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_ISMODIFIABLE               Possible to Change a Rule for Transaction Type              .
IF_FTR_RULESET_MGR             I TT_MODIFY                     Add a Rule for Transaction Type                             .
IF_FTR_XI_GENERAL_MAPPING_BADI I POST_MAPPING                  Mapping after Calling Derivation Tool                       .
IF_FTR_XI_GENERAL_MAPPING_BADI I PRE_MAPPING                   Mapping before Calling Derivation Tool                      .
IF_FTR_XI_IF_MAPPING_BADI      I GET_ID_TYPES                  Determine ID Types for Conversion of Partners               .
IF_FTR_XI_IF_MAPPING_BADI      I MAPPING                       Mapping of Treasury Transactions                            .
IF_FUNCTION_PROCESSOR_BRF      I PROCESS_EXPRESSION            Calculates Specified Expression                             .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I DISPLAY_APPLICATION_LOG       Display Application Log                                     .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I GET_APPLICATION_LOG           Transfer Application Log                                    .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I GET_DYNPRO_STATUS             Screen Information                                          .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           Process User Command                                        .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I LEAVE_CONTEXT                 Confirmation Prompt                                         .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I PROCESS_COMPONENT             Activate Component                                          .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I REFRESH_COMPONENT             Update Active Components                                    .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I REFRESH_NAVIGATOR             Update Navigator                                            .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I REMOVE_APPLICATION_LOG        Empty and Remove Application Log                            .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_APPLICATION  I SET_NEXT_COMPONENT            Define Subsequent Component                                 .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_COMPONENT    I GET_COMPONENT_ID              Determine Component IDs                                     .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_COMPONENT    I GET_IF_MODEL_COMPONENT        Retrieve Reference to Accompanying Model                    .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_COMPONENT    I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           Process User Entries                                        .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_COMPONENT    I LEAVE                         Leave Component                                             .
IF_FVD_CONTROLLER_COMPONENT    I PROCESS                       Start Component                                             .
IF_FVD_FCAT_PROFILE            I GET_PROFILE                   Returns a Profile for the Field Catalog                     .
IF_FVD_FCAT_PROFILE            I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets the Context                                            .
IF_FVD_FIELDCATALOG            I GET_FIELD_CATALOG             Specify Field Catalog                                       .
IF_FVD_FIELDCATALOG            I MODIFY_ALV_FIELDCAT           Gets Field Status for Transferred Field Catalog             .
IF_FVD_FIELDCATALOG            I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Gets Field Status for Transferred Field                     .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CHECKLIST   I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CHECKLIST   I GET_VALUES                    Read Values                                                 .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CHECKLIST   I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CHECKLIST   I SET_VALUES                    Write Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CLERKS      I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CLERKS      I GET_VALUES                    Read Values                                                 .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CLERKS      I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_CLERKS      I SET_VALUES                    Write Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_DISBURSE    I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_DISBURSE    I GET_VALUES                    Read Values                                                 .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_DISBURSE    I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_DISBURSE    I SET_VALUES                    Write Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_PARTNER     I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_PARTNER     I GET_VALUES                    Read Values                                                 .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_PARTNER     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_PARTNER     I SET_VALUES                    Write Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_SETTLEMENT  I CHECK_VALUES                  Check Values                                                .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_SETTLEMENT  I GET_VALUES                    Read Values                                                 .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_SETTLEMENT  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_FVD_LOAN_FACADE_SETTLEMENT  I SET_VALUES                    Set Values                                                  .
IF_FVD_LOS                     I HANDLE_COND                   Method for Customer-Specific Handling of Condition Data     .
IF_FVD_LOS                     I HANDLE_MD                     Method for Customer-Specific Handling of Master Data        .
IF_FVD_LOS                     I HANDLE_PARTNER                Method for Customer-Specific Handling of Partner Data       .
IF_FVD_MD_VIEW_LOAN            I GET_CUSTOMER_CONDITION_LAYOUT Define Layout for Condition Details                         .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I AFTER_COMMIT                  Execution After COMMIT                                      .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I AFTER_FAILED_SAVE             Execution After ROLLBACK                                    .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I BEFORE_SAVE                   Execution before DO_SAVE                                    .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Write Data (Simulation Run)                                 .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I DO_CLEANUP                    Initialize Data                                             .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I DO_RETRIEVE                   Read Data                                                   .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I DO_SAVE                       Write data                                                  .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I GET_STATUS                    Determine Status of a Component                             .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I IS_DISPLAY_ONLY               Is the Component in Display Mode?                           .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I IS_MODIFIED                   Was Data Changed?                                           .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I SET_INSTANCE_ID               Select Instance                                             .
IF_FVD_MODEL_COMPONENT         I SET_MODE                      Set Display Mode                                            .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_ACCOUNT      I GET_PARTNER                   Read Partners                                               .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I GET_ACCOUNT_SERVICES          Service Class as Return Value                               .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I GET_EDIT_STATUS               Can Contract Be Changed?                                    .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I GET_LOAN_DATA                 Loan Data                                                   .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I GET_PROFILE_DATA              Get Profile Data for Field Control                          .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I IS_INITIALIZED                Is Loan Core Account Initialized?                           .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I SET_CONDITION_DATA            Transfer Conditions to Loan Core Account                    .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I SET_DEFAULT_DATA              Transfer Default to Loan Core Account                       .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I SET_MASTER_DATA               Transfer Master Data to Loan Core Account                   .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_MD_LOAN      I SET_PARTNER_DATA              Transfer Partner to Loan Core Account                       .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_OBJ_LOCATOR  I GET_ACCOUNT                   Determine Contract Number of Object Locator                 .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_OBJ_LOCATOR  I GET_COMP_CODE                 Determine Company Code for Object Locator                   .
IF_FVD_MODEL_SERV_OBJ_LOCATOR  I GET_PARTNER                   Determine Partner for Object Locator                        .
IF_FVD_OUT_BPARTNER_CVI        I CHECK_CUSTOMER_IN_CCODE       Check if Customer Account Exists in Company Code            .
IF_FVD_OUT_BPARTNER_CVI        I CREATE_CUSTOMER_IN_CCODE      Create Customer Account in Company Code                     .
IF_FVD_OUT_BPARTNER_CVI        I CREATE_CUSTOMER_IN_CCODE_DI   Create Customer Account in Company Code (Direct Input)      .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I DISPLAY_PARTNER_DETAIL        Partner Detailed Display                                    .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_PARTNER_ADDRESSES         Determine Address List for Partner                          .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_PARTNER_COMM_DATA         Determine Communication Data for Partner                    .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_PARTNER_CUSTOMER          Determine Customer Number of Partner                        .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_PARTNER_LIST_BY_NAME      Determine List of Partners Using Names                      .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_PARTNER_NAME              Determine Name of Partner                                   .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_ROLECATEGORY              Determine Business Partner Role Category for BP Role        .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I GET_ROLE_DESCRIPTION          Determine Role Description for Business Partner Role        .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I IS_ROLE_ASSIGNED              Is Business Partner Role Assigned to Parner?                .
IF_FVD_OUT_BUSINESSPARTNER     I SEARCH_PARTNER_NUMBER         Seach for Business Partner Number                           .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Write Data (Simulation Run)                                 .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I DO_CLEANUP                    Initialize Data                                             .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I DO_RETRIEVE                   Read Data                                                   .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I DO_SAVE                       Write data                                                  .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I IS_DEAFULT_IMP                Returns 'X' if there is no other active implementation      .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I IS_MODIFIED                   Was Data Changed?                                           .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I SET_INSTANCE_ID               Select Instance                                             .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I SET_MODE                      Set Display Mode                                            .
IF_FVD_OUT_COLLATERAL          I START_COLLATERAL_APPL         Start Collateral Application                                .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I CALC_REBATE                   Read Insurance                                              .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I GET_INS_POL_LIST              Read Insurance                                              .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I GIVE_NOTICE_POL               Give Notice for Insurance Policy                            .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I REVERSE_NOTICE_POL            Give Notice for Insurance Policy                            .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I START_INS_APPL_CREATE         Create - Start Insurance System                             .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I START_INS_APPL_DISPLAY        Display - Start Insruance System                            .
IF_FVD_OUT_INSURANCE           I START_INS_APPL_UPDATE         Change - Start Insurance System                             .
IF_FVD_OUT_POST_PROCESSING     I ADD_ORDER                     Insert Postprocessing Order                                 .
IF_FVD_OUT_POST_PROCESSING     I INIT                          Initialization of Postprocessing                            .
IF_FVD_OUT_POST_PROCESSING     I SAVE                          Save Postprocessing Orders                                  .
IF_FVD_OUT_POST_PROCESSING     I START_LOG_REC                 Start Recording in Application Log                          .
IF_FVD_OUT_POST_PROCESSING     I STOP_LOG_REC                  Stop Recording in Application Log                           .
IF_FVD_VIEW_NAVIGATOR_ELEMENT  I DISPLAY                       Display                                                     .
IF_FWWP_FACTORY                I CREATE                        Object Generation                                           .
IF_GCM_PSB_HANDLER             I OPEN_BROWSER                  Start the Product Structure Browser                         .
IF_GENIL_APPL_ALTERNATIVE_DSIL I CHECK_OBJECTS_BEFORE_SAVE     Check Objects Before Saving                                 .
IF_GENIL_APPL_ALTERNATIVE_DSIL I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete Root Objects                                         .
IF_GENIL_APPL_ALTERNATIVE_DSIL I INIT_OBJECTS                  Reset Buffer Objects                                        .
IF_GENIL_APPL_ALTERNATIVE_DSIL I LOCK_OBJECTS                  Lock Objects                                                .
IF_GENIL_APPL_ALTERNATIVE_DSIL I SAVE_OBJECTS                  Save Objects                                                .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I CHECK_OBJECTS_BEFORE_SAVE     Check Objects Before Saving                                 .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I CREATE_OBJECTS                Generate Root Objects                                       .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete Root Objects                                         .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I EXECUTE_OBJECT_METHOD         Execute Methods for Business Objects                        .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I GET_OBJECTS                   Read Attributes and Object Relations                        .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I GET_QUERY_RESULT              Execute Search Requests                                     .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I GET_VIEW                      Read Modelled View                                          .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I INIT_OBJECTS                  Reset Buffer Objects                                        .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I LOCK_OBJECTS                  Lock Objects                                                .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I MODIFY_OBJECTS                Write Attributes                                            .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I RESET                         Reset All Buffers                                           .
IF_GENIL_APPL_INTLAY           I SAVE_OBJECTS                  Save Objects                                                .
IF_GENIL_APPL_MODEL            I GET_MODEL                     Returns the Object Model for an Application Component       .
IF_GENIL_APPL_MODEL            I GET_OBJECT_PROPS              Returns Object Attributes                                   .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I ADD_CHILD                     Add a Direct Subordinate Object                             .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I ADD_FOREIGN_RELATION          Insert a Relation to a Non-Container Object                 .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I COPY_SELF_WITH_STRUCTURE      Copy Object Together with Its Substructure                  .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns a List Object of Direct Subordinate Objects         .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_CHILDREN_IN_11_RELATIONS  Returns a List Object of Subordinate Objects in 1:1 Relation.
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_CHILDREN_IN_1N_RELATIONS  Returns a List Object of Subordinate Objects in 1:n Relation.
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_FOREIGN_RELATIONS         Read All Relations for Non-Container Object                 .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_OWNED_CHILDREN            Returns a List Object of Subordinate Objects in 1:1 Relation.
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_PARENT                    Returns Higher-Level Node                                   .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_PARENT_RELATION           Returns the Names of Relations for the Subordinate Object   .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_QUERY_ROOT                Returns the Query Root Flag                                 .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_REFERENCED_CHILDREN       Returns a List Object of Subordinate Objects in 1:1 Relation.
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_RELATION                  Returns a List Object of the Subobjects in Given Relation   .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I GET_ROOT                      Returns the Root Object                                     .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I IS_PARENT_RELATION_11         Checks if Relation to Higher-Level Object Is a 1:1 Relation .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I SET_FOREIGN_RELATION          Set Keys for a Relation for Non-Container Objects           .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECT      I SET_QUERY_ROOT                Sets the Query Root Flag                                    .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I GET_FIRST                     Returns First Object                                        .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I GET_LAST                      Returns Last Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I GET_PARENT                    Returns the Higher-Level Nodes in the List                  .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I REWIND                        Reset List Display                                          .
IF_GENIL_CONTAINER_OBJECTLIST  I SIZE                          Returnss the Number of Objects in List                      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECT      I GET_QUERY_ROOT                Gets the Query Root Flag                                    .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECT      I GET_TYPE_LIST                 Returnss a List of All Object Types in the Container        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECT      I SET_MESSAGE_CONTAINER         Set a New Message Container for the Object                  .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECT      I SET_QUERY_ROOT                Set the Query Root Flag                                     .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I ADD_OBJECT                    Add a Root Object                                           .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I GET_FIRST                     Returns First Object                                        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I GET_GLOBAL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER  Returns the Global Message Container                        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I GET_LAST                      Returns Last Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I REWIND                        Reset List Display                                          .
IF_GENIL_CONT_ROOT_OBJECTLIST  I SIZE                          Returns the Number of Objects in List                       .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I ADD_FOREIGN_RELATION          Add a Relation to a Non-Container Object                    .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I CHECK_ATTR_REQUESTED          Returns Flag Indicating Whether Attributes Should Be Read   .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I CHECK_RELS_REQUESTED          Returns Flag Indicating Whether Relations Should Be Read    .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the Object Attribute Structure                      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_ATTR_PROPS_OBJ            Returns an Empty Property Object for Object Attributes      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_ATTR_STRUCT_NAME          Returns the DDIC Type for the Object's Attribute Structure  .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_DELTA_FLAG                Returns the Delta Flag                                      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_FOREIGN_RELATIONS         Read All Relations for Non-Container Object                 .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_GLOBAL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER  Returns the Global Message Container                        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_HANDLE                    Returns the Object Handle                                   .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_KEY                       Returns the Object Key                                      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_KEY_STRUCT_NAME           Returns the DDIC Type of Object's Key Structure             .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_MESSAGE_CONTAINER         Returns the Relevant Message Container                      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_NAME                      Returns the Object Name                                     .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I GET_OBJECT_ID                 Read Internal Object ID                                     .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets the Object's Attribute Structure in the Container      .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I SET_DELTA_FLAG                Sets the Delta Flag                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I SET_FOREIGN_RELATION          Set Keys for a Relation for Non-Container Objects           .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I SET_HANDLE                    Sets a Handle as Object ID                                  .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJECT    I SET_KEY                       Sets a Logical Key as Object ID                             .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I ADD_OBJECT                    Add a Root Object                                           .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I GET_FIRST                     Returns First Object                                        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I GET_GLOBAL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER  Returns the Global Message Container                        .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I GET_LAST                      Returns Last Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I GET_OBJECT_NAME               Returns the Names of List Objects                           .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I REWIND                        Reset List Display                                          .
IF_GENIL_CONT_SIMPLE_OBJLIST   I SIZE                          Returns the Number of Objects in List                       .
IF_GENIL_ITERATOR              I CHECK_HAS_MORE                Check at End of List                                        .
IF_GENIL_ITERATOR              I GET_FIRST                     Returns First Object                                        .
IF_GENIL_ITERATOR              I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Object                                         .
IF_GENIL_ITERATOR              I REWIND                        Position on First Object                                    .
IF_GENIL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER     I DELETE_MESSAGES               Delete Messages (for One Object)                            .
IF_GENIL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER     I GET_MESSAGES                  Returns Messages                                            .
IF_GENIL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER     I GET_NUMBER_OF_MESSAGES        Gets the Number of Messages                                 .
IF_GENIL_MSG_SERVICE_ACCESS    I GET_GLOBAL_MESSAGE_CONTAINER  Returns the Global Message Container                        .
IF_GENIL_MSG_SERVICE_ACCESS    I GET_MESSAGE_CONTAINER         Returns the Relevant Message Container                      .
IF_GENIL_MSG_SERVICE_ACCESS    I SET_MESSAGE_CONTAINER         Set a New Message Container for the Object                  .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I GET_IDX_TAB_4_PROPERTY        Returns a Table of All Indexes with Specified Property      .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I GET_NAME_TAB_4_PROPERTY       Returns a Table of All Names with Specified Property        .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I GET_PROPERTY_BY_IDX           Read an Attribute Property with Attribute Index             .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I GET_PROPERTY_BY_NAME          Read an Attribute Property with Attribute Name              .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I GET_UNIQUE_PROPERTY           Returns the Property That Is Valid for All Attributes       .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I SET_ALL_PROPERTIES            Sets the Property for all Attributes to the Given Value     .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I SET_ALL_PROPERTIES_WITH_FILTERSets the Property for all Attributes to the Given Value     .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I SET_PROPERTY_BY_IDX           Set an Attribute Property with Attribute Index              .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_ATTR_PROPERTIES   I SET_PROPERTY_BY_NAME          Read an Attribute Property with Attribute Name              .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ATTR_IDX_BY_NAME          Returns the Attribute Index for the Specified Name          .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ATTR_NAME_BY_IDX          Returns the Attribute Name for the Specified Index          .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ATTR_NUMBER               Returns the Number of Object Attributes                     .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ATTR_STRUCT_NAME          Returns the Names of Attributes DDIC Structure              .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ATTR_TYPE                 Returns the DDIC Type of an Attribute                       .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_COMPONENT_NAME            Returns Components for an Object                            .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_CREATE_STRUCT_NAME        Returns the DDIC Structure Names for the Create Parameter   .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_KEY_STRUCT_NAME           Returns the Names of the Key DDIC Structure                 .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_METHOD_PARAM_STRUCT_NAME  Returns the Name of the DDIC Structure for Method Parameters.
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_METHOD_PARAM_TYPE         Returns the DDIC Type of Method Parameter                   .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_MODELED_METHODS           Returns Object Methods                                      .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_MODELED_RELATIONS         Returns All Prospective Relations from Object               .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_OBJECT_KIND               Returns Type for an Object                                  .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Returns a List of All Modeled Objects                       .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_PARENT_OBJECTS            Returns All Higher-Level Objects for an Object              .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_RELATED_OBJECT            Returns the Target Object for a Relation                    .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_RELATED_PARENT            Returns the Source Object for a Relation                    .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_RELATIONS_BETWEEN         Returns all Relations Between Two Objects                   .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_RELATION_KIND             Returns the Type for a Relation                             .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I GET_ROOT_OBJECT               Returns the Higher-Level Root Object for an Object          .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I IS_ACCESS_OBJECT              Check Whether a Given Object is an Access Object            .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I IS_VALID_METHOD               Checks Whether a Given Method is Possible for an Object     .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I OBJECT_MUST_BE_ERROR_FREE     Check Whether a Given Object is an Access Object            .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I RELATION_IS_11                Check Whether the Relation Specified Is a 1:1 Relation      .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_MODEL             I RELATION_IS_CACHEABLE         Check Whether the Given Relation Can Be Saved in Buffer     .
IF_GENIL_OBJ_REQUEST_SPEC      I CHECK_ATTRIBUTES_REQUESTED    Checks Whether Object Attributes Should Be Read             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I ADD_11_RELATIONS              Adds 1:1 Relations to an Object                             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I ADD_1N_RELATIONS              Adds 1:n Relations to an Object                             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I ADD_IDS_IN_1N_RELATION        Adds Object Reference to a 1:n Object Relation              .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I ADD_OBJECT                    Adds an Object                                              .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I GET_11_RELATIONS              Read 1:1 Relations of an Object                             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I GET_1N_RELATIONS              Read 1:n Relations of an Object                             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I GET_OBJECT_ATTRIBUTES         Read Object Attributes                                      .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Reads Back the List of All Objects in Container             .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I GET_OBJECT_NAME               Returns the Business Object Type of the Container           .
IF_GENIL_SIMPLE_DATA_CONTAINER I SET_OBJECT_ATTRIBUTES         Set Attributes for an Object                                .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check Whether Instances Can Be Saved                        .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I CREATE                        Generate a Qty of Object Instances According to Parameters  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I DELETE                        Delete Instances                                            .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I DESTROY                       Destructor Method for Instance                              .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I EXECUTE_METHOD                Execute an Instance Method                                  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Attributes and Relations of Instances               .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I GET_LIST                      Returns a List of Instances That Fulfill Search Parameters  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I INIT                          Reset Buffer for Instances                                  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I LOCK                          Lock Instances                                              .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I MODIFY                        Change Attributes and Relations of Instances in Buffer      .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER            I SAVE                          Save Instances                                              .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check Whether Instances Can Be Saved                        .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I CREATE                        Generate a Qty of Object Instances According to Parameters  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I DELETE                        Delete Instances                                            .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I DESTROY                       Destructor Method for Instance                              .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I EXECUTE_METHOD                Execute an Instance Method                                  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Attributes and Relations of Instances               .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I GET_LIST                      Returns a List of Instances That Fulfill Search Parameters  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I INIT                          Reset Buffer for Instances                                  .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I LOCK                          Lock Instances                                              .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I MODIFY                        Change Attributes and Relations of Instances in Buffer      .
IF_GENIL_SO_HANDLER2           I SAVE                          Save Instances                                              .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I EXECUTE_ACTION                Execute Default Action                                      .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns Dependent Nodes                                     .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Returns Context Menu for Node                               .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I GET_NAME                      Returns Node Name                                           .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I GET_NODE_TEXT                 Returns Node Text                                           .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I GET_TREE_DATA                 Returns Output Data for Node                                .
IF_GENIL_TREE_NODE             I PROCESS_CONTEXT_MENU_ENTRY    Process Context Menu Command                                .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_APPLOBJID                 get_logsys, get_objtype, get_objsubtype, get_objkey together.
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_LOCKMODE                  Gets current object lock mode                               .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_LOGSYS                    Gets original object log. system                            .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_OBJKEY                    Gets the semantic key of the object (in char(70))           .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_OBJTYPE                   Gets the object type (char10=SWO_OBJTYPE)                   .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I GET_OOCLASSNAME               Gets the object class name (for typecasts)                  .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECT               I WRITE_ABSTRACT                Writes a short abstract of the object                       .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECTCONTAINER      I BUF_CLEAR                     Deletes internal buffer                                     .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECTCONTAINER      I BUF_READBYAPPLOBJID           Bulk data read using keys                                   .
IF_GEOAPPLOBJECTCONTAINER      I GET_TAB_GEOAPPLOBJECT         Gets a table of pointers to the appl. objects               .
IF_GEOCODING_TOOL              I GEOCODE                       Geocoding from 1-N Addresses of a Country                   .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I BUF_CLEAR                     Delete internal table                                       .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I BUF_DELETE                    Delete Geoobjekt from internal table                        .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I BUF_FLUSH_DELETE              Flush buffer in DB                                          .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I BUF_FLUSH_UPDATE              Flush buffer in DB                                          .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I BUF_INSERT                    Buffered update for array access                            .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I DELETE                        A GeoLoc/Objr has changed. Mapper tab update required       .
IF_GEOMAPPER                   I UPDATE                        New GeoLoc/ObjR. Entry in mapping table may be required     .
IF_GET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS       I GET_ADDITIONAL_DATA           Get additional data for the customer fields                 .
IF_GET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS       I GET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDS         Get additional fields of the customer                       .
IF_GFS_REPOSITORY              I CREATE_SEARCHDEF              Call IF_GFS_DEFINITION-"BEGIN_EDIT implicitly               .
IF_GFS_REPOSITORY              I CREATE_VIEW                   Call IF_GFS_DEFINITION-"BEGIN_EDIT implicitly               .
IF_GFS_REPOSITORY              I EXTEND_SEARCHDEF              Only an active def. can be extended. call BEGIN_EDIT implic..
IF_GFS_REPOSITORY              I EXTEND_VIEW                   Only an active def. can be extended. call BEGIN_EDIT implic..
IF_GFW_STATUS                  I COPY                          Create copy                                                 .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I ADD_STOP                      Adds a stop to the route                                    .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I EXECUTE                       Executes route request                                      .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_PART_BORDER               Get the border of a specific part                           .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_PART_COUNT                Get the part count of the route                             .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_PART_INFO                 Get informations about a specific part                      .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_PART_PATH                 Get the path of a specific part                             .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_ROUTE_BORDER              Get the border of the whole route                           .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_ROUTE_INFO                Get informations about the whole route                      .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_ROUTE_PATH                Get the path of the whole route                             .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_SEGMENT_BORDER            Get the border of a specific segment                        .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_SEGMENT_COUNT             Get the segment count of a specific part                    .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_SEGMENT_INFO              Get informations about a specific segment                   .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I GET_SEGMENT_PATH              Get the path of a specific segment                          .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I RESET                         Resets the route data                                       .
IF_GIS_ROUTE                   I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets a route request property                               .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I ADD_OBJECT                    Adds an object (point or line) to the map                   .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I CLEAR                         Removes all objects from the map                            .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_BORDER                    Returns the actual map border                               .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_IMAGE                     Returns the generated map image                             .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_IMAGEMAP                  Returns the generated image map in HTML format              .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_LEGEND_HTML               Returns the generated legend HTML (optional)                .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_LEGEND_IMAGE              Returns the generated legend image (optional)               .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I GET_SIZE                      Returns the map image size                                  .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I MODIFY_OBJECT                 Modifies an object on the map                               .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I MOVE                          Moves the map up, down, left or right                       .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I MOVE_TO_POSITION              Moves the map to a specific position                        .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I REMOVE_OBJECT                 Removes an object from the map                              .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I SIZE                          Resizes the map image                                       .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I UPDATE                        Updates the map image                                       .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I ZOOM                          Zooms the map in or out                                     .
IF_GIS_VIEW                    I ZOOM_TO_BORDER                Zooms the map to a given border                             .
IF_GLOBAL_TRIGGER_POC          I GET_DETAILS                   Outputs Detail Information about Trigger                    .
IF_GLOBAL_TRIGGER_POC          I GET_EVT_PARAMS                Outputs Event Parameters                                    .
IF_GLOBAL_TRIGGER_POC          I RAISE_EVENT_FROM_EXTERNAL     Trigger Event Externally                                    .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I CHECK_DATA                    Checks the Screen Data                                      .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I GET_DATA                      Gets the Time-Independent Asset Master Data                 .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I INIT_BY_ASSET_KEY             Initializes Manager via Asset Key                           .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Asset Data                                      .
IF_GLO_MASTER_DATA_MNGR        I SET_DATA                      Sets the Time-Independent Asset Master Data                 .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I CHECK_FIELD_RULES             Checks If All Screen Layout Rules Followed                  .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I CHECK_TMINTRVL                Checks the Screen Data                                      .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I DELETE_TMINTRVL               Deletes a Time Interval                                     .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I GET_TMINTRVL                  Gets the Time Interval of the Value Date                    .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I INIT_BY_ASSET_KEY             Initializes Manager via Asset Key                           .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_GLO_TD_AMD_MNGR             I SET_TMINTRVL                  Adds to or Changes a Time Interval                          .
IF_GMAVC_ENTRY                 I COLLECT_BUD                   Collect data for GM budgeting                               .
IF_GMAVC_ENTRY                 I COLLECT_UPD                   Collect data for GM posting                                 .
IF_GMAVC_LEDGER                I COLLECT_BUD                   Collect budgeting data for AVC check                        .
IF_GMAVC_LEDGER                I COLLECT_UPD                   Collect GM posting data for AVC check                       .
IF_GOS_CALLBACK                I GET_OBJECT                    Determine BOR Object Dynamically                            .
IF_GOS_RELATIONS               I ADD_BUTTONS_FOR_ITEMS         Pushbutton for Relationship Tree                            .
IF_GOS_RELATIONS               I ADD_BUTTONS_FOR_LINKS         Pushbutton for Relationship List                            .
IF_GOS_RELATIONS               I ADD_CMD_HANDLER               Transfer IF_CMD_HANDLER                                     .
IF_GOS_RELATIONS               I DISPLAY_OBJECT                Display Object                                              .
IF_GOS_SERVICE_MULTIPLE        I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execute Function                                            .
IF_GOS_SERVICE_MULTIPLE        I GET_FUNCTION_LIST             Function Selection List                                     .
IF_GOS_SERVICE_TOOLS           I COPY_SERVICE_OBJECTS          Copy Objects to a Different Business Object                 .
IF_GOS_SERVICE_TOOLS           I DELETE_SERVICE_OBJECTS        Deletion of Objects for Business Object                     .
IF_GOS_SERVICE_TOOLS           I MOVE_SERVICE_OBJECTS          Reassignment of Objects to a Different Business Object      .
IF_GP_HIER                     I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Reads the selected nodes                                    .
IF_GP_HIER                     I SET_SELECTED_NODES            Sets the selected nodes (select nodes)                      .
IF_GP_MAIN                     I NOTIFY                        Notify main proxy                                           .
IF_GP_MAIN                     I SET_SUBPROXIES                Tell main proxy about its subproxies                        .
IF_GP_NOTIFICATION             I NOTIFY                        Data container informs...                                   .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I CONVERT_EVENT_GUI2ABAP        Convert a GUI event into an ABAP event                      .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I EVTID_INT2PROD                Convert an event code into a product-specific event code    .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I FILL                          Fill the graphic with data                                  .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I FREE                          Delete object                                               .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I INIT                          Initialize the object                                       .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I MARK_CUOBJ_LIST_CHANGED       Mark list of customizing objects to be changed              .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I PRINT                         Print graphic                                               .
IF_GP_PRODUCT                  I SEND_EVENT_ABAP2GUI           Send an ABAP event to the GUI/front end                     .
IF_GP_PRODUCT_EXPORT           I EXPORT                        Get graphic as export/picture                               .
IF_GP_SUB                      I GET_EVENTS                    Get events                                                  .
IF_GP_SUB                      I GET_PROXY                     Get reference to product-specific section of GP             .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I ACTIVATE                      Activate graphic (-" visible)                               .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I ADD_CU_BUNDLE                 Customizing: Add attribute bundle                           .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivate graphic (-" invisible)                           .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I DEL_CU_BUNDLE                 Customizing: Remove attribute bundle                        .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I ENSURE_OBJECT_LIST_VISIBLE    Ensure visibility of objects                                .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I EXPORT                        Get graphic as export/picture                               .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I FREE                          Destructor replacement                                      .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I GET_CU_BUNDLE                 Customizing: Get attribute bundle (added by add_cu_bundle)  .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I INIT                          Constructor: Initialize Graphic Proxy                       .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I LOAD_CUSTOMIZING              Customizing: Load the settings from the database            .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I PRINT                         Print graphic                                               .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SAVE_CUSTOMIZING              Customizing: Save the (changed) settings in the database    .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SEND_EVENT                    Send/distribute (internal) event                            .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SET_BEHAVIOR_LIST             Set list of Drag&Drop behavior                              .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SET_EVENT_LIST                Set event code list                                         .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SET_FILTER_LIST               Set filter list                                             .
IF_GRAPHIC_PROXY               I SET_PARAMETER                 Set parameter (see CO_PARAM_...)                            .
IF_GRAPH_CUSTOM_MODEL          I GET_CUSTOM_XML                Returns the custom XML in utf-8 encoded string table        .
IF_GRAPH_DATA_MODEL            I GET_DATA_XML                  Returns the data XML as utf-8 encoded string table          .
IF_GRT_SRV_IFRAME_DIM_OVERRIDE I OVERRIDE_DIMENSIONS           Use this method to override the Iframe dimensions           .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I BEFORE_EXPORT                 Fill Shadow Tables Before Export                            .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I CHECK                         Consistency Check                                           .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I ENABLE_TRANSPORT              Prepare Object for Transport (e.g. Table Conversion)        .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I GET_CHILDREN                  Objects Contained Directly                                  .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I GET_PARENTS                   Directly Superordinate Objects                              .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I GET_TABKEYS                   Get Table Keys (for E071K) from Transport Objects           .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I GET_TRANSPORT_OBJECTS         Get Transport Objects from E071K                            .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I IMPORT_FINISHED               Subsequent Processing at End of Import                      .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Instance Variables                               .
IF_GRW_TRANSPORT_UTIL          I UPDATE_AFTER_IMPORT           Database Changes after Import                               .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ADD_COLOR                     Add Frog Color to Color Pallet                              .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ADD_LINK                      Add Link                                                    .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ADD_TABLE                     Add Table                                                   .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ARRANGE_OBJECTS               Refresh Objects                                             .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ARRANGE_SINGLE_TABLE          Allocate Table to Network without Overlaps                  .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I CREATE_NEW_LINK_STYLE         Generates a New Link Style                                  .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete Objects                                              .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I ENSURE_VISIBLE                Table Moved to Visible Area                                 .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I FREE_IT                       Delete Attributes and Exit                                  .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_CENTRAL_OBJECT            Delivers Table Nearest to the Center                        .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_NEW_LINK                  Delivers New Link                                           .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_NEW_TABLE                 Delivers New Table Object                                   .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_POSITION_OF_OBJECTS       Delivers Position of all Objects                            .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_SELECTED_OBJECTS          Delivers Selected Objects                                   .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I GET_ZOOM                      Delivers zoom                                               .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I PRINT                         Print Network                                               .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SAVE_AS_JPG                   Save as jpg                                                 .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SEND_DATA_TO_FRONTEND         Newly Added Objects Sent to Frontend                        .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_ACTIVEMODE                Set Mode for Generating Links                               .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_BACKGROUNDCOLOR           Set background color                                        .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_DISPLAYONLY               Switch on/off Display Mode                                  .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_DRAGDROP_HANDLE           Set D&D Handle for Network Control                          .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_NAVIGATION_VISIBLE        Set Naviagtor Visibility                                    .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_ROTATION                  Set Network Configuration (0-3)                             .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_SELECTED_OBJECTS          Mark Objects as Selected                                    .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_TABLEDISTANCE             Set Distance Between Tables                                 .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_TITLE                     Set Title for Network                                       .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_VISIBILITY                Set Visibility of Objects                                   .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC              I SET_ZOOM                      Set Zoom (1-200%)                                           .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC_INTERNAL     I DELETE_ROW                    Deletes Row from Internal Tables                            .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC_INTERNAL     I GET_DEFAULTTABLEHEADSTYLE     Delivers Format Style and Font Style for Default Table Head .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC_INTERNAL     I GET_NEWOBJECTID               Delivers New Object ID                                      .
IF_GUI_AQQGRAPHIC_INTERNAL     I GET_STYLE                     Delivers Style                                              .
IF_GUI_DYNAMIC_DATA            I ON_EXECUTE_NODE               End of a Node                                               .
IF_GUI_DYNAMIC_DATA            I ON_NEW_NODE                   New Data for Control Proxy                                  .
IF_GUI_DYNAMIC_DATA            I ON_VALUE                      Call Processing of new Value Pair                           .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_CHANGE                  Check if CHANGE is Valid for Transmitted Nodes              .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_CHANGE_COMPLETE         Check if follow up necessary for CHANGE                     .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_COPY                    Check if COPY is Valid for Transmitted Nodes                .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_COPY_COMPLETE           Check if follow up necessary for COPY                       .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_CUT                     Check if CUT is Valid for Transmitted Nodes                 .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_CUT_COMPLETE            Check if follow up necessary for CUT                        .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_DETAIL                  Check if DETAIL is valid for transmitted nodes              .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_DETAIL_COMPLETE         Check if follow-up necessary for DETAIL                     .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_NEW                     Check if New is Valid for Transmitted Nodes                 .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_NEW_COMPLETE            Check if follow up necessary for NEW                        .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_PASTE                   Check if PASTE is Valid for Transmitted Nodes               .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I CHECK_PASTE_COMPLETE          Check if follow up necessary for PASTE                      .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I GET_ALV_LAYOUT_FOR_ASSIGNMENTSGet Layout of Assignment Area                               .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I GET_ALV_LAYOUT_FOR_GRAPH_LEFT Get Layout of Left Graph                                    .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I GET_ALV_LAYOUT_FOR_GRAPH_RIGHTGet Layout of Right Graph                                   .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I GET_ALV_LAYOUT_FOR_NAVIGATION Get Layout of Navigation Area                               .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I GET_PATTERN_FOR_NEW_NODE      Reference Data for Newly Created Nodes                      .
IF_GUI_RFW                     I SET_TEXTS                     Fill Text Fields                                            .
IF_GUI_RSGM_NETWORK            I ADD_LINK_TO_NETWORK           Adding a Link to the Network                                .
IF_GUI_RSGM_NETWORK            I ADD_NODE_TO_NETWORK           Adding a Node to the Network                                .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ADD_COLOR                     Add Frog Color to Color Pallet                              .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ADD_LINK                      Add Link                                                    .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ADD_TABLE                     Add Table                                                   .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ARRANGE_OBJECTS               Refresh Objects                                             .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ARRANGE_SELECTED_OBJECTS      Refresh Selected Objects                                    .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ARRANGE_SINGLE_TABLE          Allocate Table to Network without Overlaps                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I CREATE_NEW_LINK_STYLE         Generates a New Link Style                                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete Objects                                              .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ENSURE_ROW_VISIBLE            Rows of a Table Will Be Moved into Visible Area             .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ENSURE_VISIBLE                Table Moved to Visible Area                                 .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I FREE_IT                       Delete Attributes and Exit                                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_ALL_LINKS                 Returns All Links                                           .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_ALL_TABLES                Returns All Tables                                          .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_CENTRAL_OBJECT            Delivers Table Nearest to the Center                        .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_NEW_LINK                  Delivers New Link                                           .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_NEW_TABLE                 Delivers New Table Object                                   .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_POSITION_OF_OBJECTS       Delivers Position of all Objects                            .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_ROTATION                  Returns the Alignment of the Network (0-3)                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_SCROLL_POSITION           Returns the Scrollbar Position                              .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_SELECTED_OBJECTS          Delivers Selected Objects                                   .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I GET_ZOOM                      Delivers zoom                                               .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I HIGHLIGHT_PATH                Highlight Path to Target and/or Source                      .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I PRINT                         Print Network                                               .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I PRINT_WITH_TITLE              Print with Temporary Title                                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I RESIZE_TABLE                  Set the Optimum Table Size (No Scrollbars)                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I ROTATE                        Rotate the Network 90 Degrees Clockwise                     .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SAVE_AS_JPG                   Save as jpg                                                 .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SEND_DATA_TO_FRONTEND         Newly Added Objects Sent to Frontend                        .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_ACTIVEMODE                Set Mode for Generating Links                               .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_BACKGROUNDCOLOR           Set Background Color                                        .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_DEFAULT_CELL_MAX_ROWS     Set Maximum Number of Visible Rows in Cells                 .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_DEFAULT_FONT_SIZE         Sets the Default Font Size                                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_DISPLAYONLY               Switch on/off Display Mode                                  .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_DRAGDROP_HANDLE           Set D&D Handle for Network Control                          .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_NAVIGATION_VISIBLE        Set Naviagtor Visibility                                    .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_ROTATION                  Set Network Configuration (0-3)                             .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_SCROLL_POSITION           Sets the Scrollbar Position                                 .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_SELECTED_OBJECTS          Mark Objects as Selected                                    .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_TABLEDISTANCE             Set Distance Between Tables                                 .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_TITLE                     Set Title for Network                                       .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_VISIBILITY                Set Visibility of Objects                                   .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC            I SET_ZOOM                      Set Zoom (1-200%)                                           .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC_INTERNAL   I DELETE_ROW                    Deletes Row from Internal Tables                            .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC_INTERNAL   I GET_DEFAULTTABLEHEADSTYLE     Delivers Format Style and Font Style for Default Table Head .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC_INTERNAL   I GET_DEFAULTTABLESTYLE         Returns Default Style for Table                             .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC_INTERNAL   I GET_NEWOBJECTID               Delivers New Object ID                                      .
IF_GUI_RSNETGRAPHIC_INTERNAL   I GET_STYLE                     Delivers Style                                              .
IF_H2O_CA_INSTANCE             I GET_STATUS_BY_OID             Object Services (H2O): Status of Object via GUID            .
IF_H2O_CA_INSTANCE             I INVALIDATE                    Object Services (H2O): Invalidates Managed Objects          .
IF_H2O_CA_INSTANCE             I INVALIDATE_OBJECT             Object Services (H2O): Invalidates one Managed Object       .
IF_H2O_CA_INSTANCE             I IS_UPTODATE_OBJECT            Object Services (H2O): DB Comparison of Object Used         .
IF_H2O_INSTANCE_MANAGER        I GET_STATUS_BY_OID             Object Services (H2O): Gets Status via GUID                 .
IF_H2O_INSTANCE_MANAGER        I INVALIDATE                    Object Services (H2O): Invalidates Managed Objects          .
IF_H2O_INSTANCE_MANAGER        I INVALIDATE_OBJECT             Object Services (H2O): Invalidates one Managed Object       .
IF_H2O_INSTANCE_MANAGER        I IS_UPTODATE_OBJECT            Object Services (H2O): DB Comparison of Object Used         .
IF_HMI_CLIENT                  I INVOKE_METHOD                 Execution of an HMI Method                                  .
IF_HR99S00_STATUS_VIEWER       I DISPLAY_DATA                  Display stored data                                         .
IF_HR99S00_STATUS_VIEWER       I MODIFY_ALV                    adapt ALV layout                                            .
IF_HR99S00_STATUS_VIEWER       I PROCESS                       Process selected entries                                    .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I CREATE_XML                    Create XML                                                  .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I DISPLAY_TEMSE                 Display Temse                                               .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I DOWNLOAD                      Download                                                    .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I REVIEW_FIELDCAT               Review fieldcat                                             .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I REVIEW_LOG_TITLES             Review log titles                                           .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I SET_FORM                      SET DAQ form instance                                       .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I SET_SEL_PARAM                 Set selection parameters                                    .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I SET_STRUCTURES                Set structures                                              .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I SET_VIEWDATE                  View date                                                   .
IF_HR99S00_TEMSE_VIEWER        I UPLOAD                        Upload                                                      .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Returns List of Authorized Users for Service                .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I CHECK_COLLISION               Checks for Collision Between Datasets                       .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I CLOSE_LUW                     Completes Trial                                             .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I DO_OPERATIONS                 Perform Operation on Fields in Buffer                       .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I FLUSH                         Flushes Data                                                .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I GET_COLLISION_IMAGE           Returns Image for Collision Detection                       .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I GET_OPERATIONS                Gets List of Operations for Service                         .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I GET_SPECIAL_FIELDS            Returns List of Special Fields for Service                  .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I GET_TECHNICAL_FIELD_INFO      Returns Technical Information of Service Fields             .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I INITIALIZE                    Return Default Values for Requested Fields                  .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I LOCK_OBJECT                   Locks Related Object                                        .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I OPEN_LUW                      Opens Trial                                                 .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I ROLLBACK_LUW                  Discards Trial                                              .
IF_HRASR00GENERIC_SERVICES     I UNLOCK_OBJECT                 Unlocks Related Object                                      .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE          I DO_OPERATIONS                 Perform Operation                                           .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE          I GET_FIELD_INFO                Determine Information for Supported Fields                  .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE          I GET_OPERATIONS                Determine Supported Operations                              .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE          I GET_SPECIAL_FIELDS            Determine Service-Specific Fields                           .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Check Authorization                                         .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I CHECK_COLLISION               Check Collision                                             .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I CLOSE_LUW                     End of "Logical Unit of Work" (LUW)                         .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I FLUSH                         Make Data Persistent                                        .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I GET_COLLISION_IMAGE           Determine Image for Collision Check                         .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I LOCK_OBJECT                   Lock                                                        .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I OPEN_LUW                      Start of "Logical Unit of Work" (LUW)                       .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I ROLLBACK_LUW                  Rejection of "Logical Unit of Work" (LUW)                   .
IF_HRASR00GEN_SERVICE_ADVANCED I UNLOCK_OBJECT                 Unlock                                                      .
IF_HRASR00PROCESS_REF_NUM      I GET_PROCESS_REF_NUM           Get Process Reference Number                                .
IF_HRASR00_AUTH_CHECK          I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Check If USER Has Authorization                             .
IF_HRASR00_AUTH_CHECK          I CHECK_MIN_AUTHORIZATION       Check If USER Has Minimum Authorization                     .
IF_HRASR00_AUTH_CHECK          I IS_OWN_OBJECT                 Check If Object Belongs to USER                             .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Check Authorization for Service Datasets                    .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I CHECK_COLLISION               Collision Check Regarding Overwriting Data Records          .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I CLOSE_LUW                     Closes/Completes Trial or LUW                               .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I DO_OPERATIONS                 Save Field Values for Operations in Buffer                  .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I FLUSH                         Flush to Database                                           .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I INITIAL_COMPUTATION           Read Default Values for Inserting New Records               .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I OPEN_LUW                      Starts Trial or LUW                                         .
IF_HRASR00_BLP_ADAPTER         I ROLLBACK_LUW                  Cancels Trial or LUW                                        .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I ASSIGN_DOCUMENT               Add Document as Case Reference                              .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES             Change Case Attributes                                      .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I CREATE_CASE                   Create Case Instance                                        .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Create KPRO Document                                        .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I DELETE                        Delete Current Case Object                                  .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I DELETE_NOTES                  Delete All Notes Assigned to Case                           .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I DELETE_RELATION               Delete Link Between Case and Objects                        .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I DOCUMENT_DELETE               Delete Document                                             .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I FIND_CASE_GUIDS_BY_ATTRIBUTES Case Search with Case Attributes (Database)                 .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Determine Value of Specific Attribute                       .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Determine All Attributes with Values of Case                .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_BOR_OBJECTS               Determine All BOR Object References of Case                 .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_CASE                      Determine Case Instance                                     .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_DOCUMENTS                 Determine All Documents of Anchor                           .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_DOCUMENTS_BY_ATTRIBUTES   Document Search with Document Attributes (Database)         .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_DOCUMENT_VERSIONS         Get All Versions of Document                                .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_NOTES                     Get All Notes of Case                                       .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_NOTES_DB                  Get All Notes of Case                                       .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_PARENT_CASE               Determine Parent Case If It Exists (Database)               .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_PARENT_CASE_FOR_BOR_OBJECTDetermine Parent Case for BOR Object (Database)             .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_PARENT_CASE_FOR_DOCUMENT  Determine Parent Case for Document (Database)               .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I GET_SUB_CASES                 Determine Subcases Inserted at Anchor                       .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I INSERT_BOR_OBJECT             Add BOR Object Reference to Case                            .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I INSERT_NOTE                   Insert Comment to Case                                      .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I INSERT_SUB_CASE               Insert Subcase Reference into Current Case                  .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I IS_CHANGED                    Is Case Changed?                                            .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I IS_PERSISTENT                 Check If Case Exists in Database                            .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I LOCK                          Lock Case                                                   .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I MODIFY_NOTE                   Modify Note                                                 .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I READ_DOCUMENT_CONTENT         Get Document Contents                                       .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I SAVE                          Save Case in Database (Without Commit)                      .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I SAVE_ALL                      Save All Cases in Database (No Commit)                      .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I UNLOCK                        Unlock Case                                                 .
IF_HRASR00_CASE                I UPDATE_DOCUMENT               Change Attributes and Content of Document                   .
IF_HRASR00_CONTENT_GROUPING    I GET_CONTENT_GROUP             Determine Content Grouping                                  .
IF_HRASR00_DAB_HISTORY         I GET_HISTORY_BROWSER           Get Singleton Instance of History Browser                   .
IF_HRASR00_DAB_HISTORY         I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Update Context Information for History Browser              .
IF_HRASR00_DATA_SELECTION_WIND I GET_SELECTION_WINDOW          Get Singleton Instance of Data Selection Window             .
IF_HRASR00_DATA_SELECTION_WIND I REFRESH_PERNR                 Initialization on Personnel Number Change                   .
IF_HRASR00_DATA_SELECTION_WIND I SET_NEW_DATA                  Set New Data in DSW                                         .
IF_HRASR00_DATA_SELECTION_WIND I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Update Context Information for Data Selection Window        .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I EXPORT_TO_MEMORY              Set All Data of DAB in ABAP Memory                          .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I IMPORT_FROM_MEMORY            Read All Data of DAB from Memory                            .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I ON_HISTORY_CONTEXT            Handle Change of History Context                            .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I REBUILD_FROM_MEMORY           Restructure DAB from Memory                                 .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I RESET_DABCD                   Initialize DABCD                                            .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I RESET_NAV_FROM_MEMORY_X       Set Navigation Parameter from Memory                        .
IF_HRASR00_DIRECT_ACCESS_BOX   I UPDATE_INFOTYPE_BROWSER       Reset Infotype Browser after Update                         .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I CHECK                         Check Data                                                  .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Authorization Check Maintenance Objects                     .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I GET_FIELD_INFO                Return of Field Attributes                                  .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I GET_SPECIAL_FIELDS            Return of Special Fields Used in Scenario                   .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I INITIALIZE                    Instantiation of Process (First Call)                       .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I INITIALIZE_FORM_STAGE         Instantiation of Form Stage                                 .
IF_HRASR00_DISPATCHER          I SAVE                          Check and Persistent Saving of Data                         .
IF_HRASR00_FSCN_SRV_UTILS      I CHECK_CUSTOMIZING             Check Service-Specific Customizing for Form Scenario/Version.
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I DESTROY_BROWSER               Destroy Browser                                             .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I EXPORT_TO_MEMORY              Set All Data of Infotype Browser in ABAP Memory             .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I IMPORT_FROM_MEMORY            Read All Data of Infotype Browser from ABAP Memory          .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I REBUILD_TREE_PART             Rebuild Part of Tree                                        .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I SET_NEW_DATA                  Transfer New Data to Infotype Browser                       .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Update Context Information for Infotype Browser             .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I UPDATE_INFTY                  Update Infotype                                             .
IF_HRASR00_INFOTYPE_BROWSER    I UPDATE_TREE_EXISTING_INFOTYPESInsert or Delete Infotype from Existing Infotypes           .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           Perform Authorization Check                                 .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I CHECK_COLLISION               Perform Collision Check                                     .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I CLOSE_LUW                     Completes Trial for LUW                                     .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I DO_OPERATIONS                 Perform Operation on Infotypes                              .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I FLUSH                         Updates to Database                                         .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I GET_COLLISION_IMAGE           Get Field Values Relevant for Collision Check               .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns Instance of Class                                   .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I GET_SPECIAL_FIELDS            Returns List of Special Fields for Service                  .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I GET_TECHNICAL_FIELD_INFO      Returns Technical Field Information                         .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Method for Process                               .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I INITIALIZE_STEP               Initialize Method for Step                                  .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I LOCK_OBJECT                   Locks Related Object                                        .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I OPEN_LUW                      Starts Trial for LUW                                        .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I ROLLBACK_LUW                  Cancels Trial for LUW                                       .
IF_HRASR00_MAPPER              I UNLOCK_OBJECT                 Unlocks Related Object                                      .
IF_HRASR00_MESSAGE_CONTEXT     I GET_CONTEXT                   Prepare Context Information for Application Log             .
IF_HRASR00_OBJECT_GROUP        I GET_OBJECT_GROUP              Evaluate Group for Object                                   .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I CHECK_COLLISION               Collision Check Regarding Overwriting Data Records          .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I CLOSE_LUW                     Closes/Completes Trial or LUW                               .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I DO_OPERATIONS                 Save Field Values for Operations in Buffer                  .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I FLUSH                         Flush to Database                                           .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I INITIAL_COMPUTATION           Read Default Values for Inserting New Records               .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I OPEN_LUW                      Starts Trial or LUW                                         .
IF_HRASR00_PAITF_ADAPTER       I ROLLBACK_LUW                  Cancels Trial or LUW                                        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I ASSIGN_ATTACHMENT             Assign Attachment to Step                                   .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I DELETE_ALL_ATTACHMENTS        Delete All Attachments Referenced from within POBJ          .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I DELETE_ATTACHMENT             Delete Previously Uploaded Attachment                       .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I GET_ALL_ATTACHMENTS_PROCESS   Get All Attachments Uploaded Against Process Object         .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I GET_ALL_ATTACHMENTS_SCENARIO  Get All Attachments Uploaded Against Scenario Object        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I GET_ALL_ATTACHMENTS_STEP      Get All Attachments Uploaded Against Step Object            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I GET_DOCCLASS_FROM_DB          Get Document Class from Database                            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I READ_ATTACHMENT               Read Previously Uploaded Attachment                         .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_ATTACHMENT     I UPLOAD_ATTACHMENT             Upload Attachment to Step Object                            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_AUTH_CHECK     I CHECK_ATTACHMENT_AUTH_USER    Check Authorization for Attachment for Specified Activity   .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_AUTH_CHECK     I CHECK_DATA_CONTAINER_AUTH_USERCheck Authorization for Data Container for Specific Activity.
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_AUTH_CHECK     I CHECK_PROCESS_AUTH_USER       Check Authorization for Process for Specified Activity      .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I DELETE_ALL_COLL_CONTAINERS    Delete All Collision Containers Referenced from Within POBJ .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I DELETE_ALL_CONTAINERS         Delete All Data Containers Referenced from within POBJ      .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_ALL_COLLISION_CONTAINERS  Get All Collision Container Contents                        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_ALL_DATA_CONTAINERS       Get All Data Container Contents                             .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_ALL_IMAGE_CONTAINERS      Get All Versions of Image Container from POBJ               .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Get Previously Stored Collision Data Container              .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_DATA_CONTAINER            Get Previously Stored Data Container                        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I GET_LATEST_DATA_CONTAINER     Get Latest Form Data Container from Scenario Object         .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I SET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Set Collision Data Container to Scenario Object             .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I SET_DATA_CONTAINER            Set Data Container to Step Object                           .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I SET_IMAGE_CONTAINER           Set Image Container in Process Object                       .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_CONTAINER      I SET_LATEST_DATA_CONTAINER     Set Latest Data Container to Scenario Object                .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I CREATE_PROCESS_OBJECT         Create Process Object                                       .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I CREATE_SCENARIO_OBJECT        Create Scenario Object                                      .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I CREATE_STEP_OBJECT            Create Step Object                                          .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I DELETE_PROCESS_OBJECT         Delete Process Object and Objects Linked to It              .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I GET_ALL_SCENARIOS             Get All Scenario GUIDs Referenced from within POBJ          .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I GET_ALL_STEPS                 Get All Step GUIDs Referenced from within Scenario          .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance of Process Runtime                             .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I GET_POBJ_BY_SCENARIO          Get POBJ GUID using Scenario GUID                           .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_FACTORY        I GET_SCENARIO_BY_STEP          Get Scenario GUID using Step GUID                           .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I CHANGE_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTES     Change Attributes of Process Object                         .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I CHANGE_SCENARIO_ATTRIBUTES    Change Attributes of Scenario Object                        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I CHANGE_STEP_ADD_ATTRIBUTES    Change Attributes of Step Object                            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I CHANGE_STEP_ATTRIBUTES        Change Attributes of Step Object                            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I DATA_SAVED_TO_BACKEND         Check If POBJ Data Is Saved to Application Backend          .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I GET_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTES        Get Attributes of Process Object                            .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I GET_SCENARIO_ATTRIBUTES       Get Attributes of Scenario Object                           .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I GET_STEP_ATTRIBUTES           Get Attributes of Step Object                               .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_HEADER_INFO    I IS_PERSISTENT                 Check Whether Object Is Persisted in Case Management        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I ASSIGN_NOTES_2_CURRENT_SCEN   Assign Note(s) to Scenario                                  .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I ASSIGN_NOTES_2_CURRENT_STEP   Assign Note(s) to Step                                      .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I DELETE_NOTE_OF_SCENARIO       Delete Note(s) from Scenario                                .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I DELETE_NOTE_OF_STEP           Delete Note(s) from Step                                    .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I GET_NOTES_OF_SCENARIO         Get Notes for Scenario                                      .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_NOTE           I GET_NOTES_OF_STEP             Get Note(s) for Step                                        .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_SAVE           I FLUSH_ALL                     Flush Case Objects to Backend                               .
IF_HRASR00_POBJ_SAVE           I LOCK_ALL                      Lock All Objects                                            .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I ADD_SCENARIO                  Create Scenario Reference Object in Process Object          .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I CREATE                        Create Process Object                                       .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I FIND_PROC_GUIDS_BY_ATTR       Process Search with Process, Scenario, Step, Doc. Attributes.
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I FIND_PROC_INSTANCES_BY_ATTTR  Proc. Instance Search with Proc, Scen, Step, Doc. Attributes.
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I GET                           Determine Process Instance                                  .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I GET_ALL_IMAGE_CONTAINERS      Get All Versions of Image Container Stored Against POBJ     .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I GET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Determine General Attributes for Process Object             .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I GET_SCENARIOS                 Determine Scenario Reference Object in Process Object       .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I SET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Specify General Attributes for Process Object               .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS             I SET_IMAGE_CONTAINER           Set Image Container in Process Object                       .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I GET_PROCESS_DETAILS           Deliver Detail Information to Processes                     .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I GET_SCENARIO_DETAILS          Deliver Detail Information to Scenarios                     .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I GET_STEP_DETAILS              Deliver Detail Information to Steps                         .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I RUNNING_PROCESSES_OF_OBJECT   Determines Current Processes for Each Object                .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I SEARCH_PROCESSES              Find Process GUIDs and Process Attributes                   .
IF_HRASR00_PROCESS_SEARCH      I SEARCH_STEPS                  Find Step GUIDs and Step Attributes                         .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I CHECK_DATA_CONTAINER_AUTH     Check Authorization for Data Container                      .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I DATA_SAVED_TO_BACKEND         Has Data Been Saved to Backend At Least Once?               .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ALL_COLLISION_CONTAINERS  Get All Collision Containers                                .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ALL_DATA_CONTAINERS       Get All Data Containers                                     .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ALL_SCENARIOS             Get All Scenarios of Process                                .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ATTACHMENTS               Get Attachments from Buffer                                 .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ATTACHMENTS_PROCESS       Get All Attachments for Process                             .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Get Collision Container from Buffer                         .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_CURRENT_NOTES             Get Current Note(s) from Step Object                        .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_DATA_CONTAINER            Get Data Container from Buffer                              .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_ERROR_MESSAGES            Get Attributes from Buffer                                  .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_IMAGE_CONTAINER           Get Image Container from Buffer                             .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance of Process Object Handler from Database or None.
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_NOTES_OF_SCENARIO         Get Notes of Scenario Object                                .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTES        Get Attributes from Buffer                                  .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_SCENARIO_ATTRIBUTES       Get Attributes from Buffer                                  .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I GET_STEP_ATTRIBUTES           Get Attributes from Buffer                                  .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_ATTACHMENT                Set Attachment to Buffer                                    .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Set Collision Container in Buffer                           .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_CURRENT_NOTE              Set Current Note                                            .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_DATA_CONTAINER            Set Data Container in Buffer                                .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_ERROR_MESSAGES            Set Attributes in Buffer                                    .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_IMAGE_CONTAINER           Set Image Container in Buffer                               .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTES        Set Attributes in Buffer                                    .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_SCENARIO_ATTRIBUTES       Set Attributes in Buffer                                    .
IF_HRASR00_PROC_OBJ_HANDLER    I SET_STEP_ATTRIBUTES           Set Attributes in Buffer                                    .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I ADD_STEP                      Add Step to Scenario                                        .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I CREATE                        Create Scenario Object                                      .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I DELETE_COLLISION_CONTAINER    Delete Collision Container                                  .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I DELETE_COMPLETE_DATA_CONTAINERDelete All Versions of Data Container                       .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I DELETE_LATEST_DATA_CONTAINER  Delete Last Version of Data Container                       .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET                           Get Scenario Object                                         .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Get Collision Container                                     .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Determine General Attributes for Process Object             .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET_LATEST_DATA_CONTAINER     Determine Current Data Container Status                     .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET_PROCESS_OBJECT            Get Parent Object = Process Object                          .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I GET_STEPS                     Get Steps of Scenario                                       .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I SET_COLLISION_CONTAINER       Set Collision Container                                     .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I SET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Specify General Attributes for Process Object               .
IF_HRASR00_SCENARIO            I SET_LATEST_DATA_CONTAINER     Specify Current Data Container Status                       .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I ASSIGN_ATTACHMENT             Assign Attachment to Step                                   .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I CREATE                        Create Step Object                                          .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I CREATE_ATTACHMENT             Create Attachment and Allocate It to Current Step           .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I DELETE_ATTACHMENT             Delete Attachment                                           .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I FIND_STEP_GUIDS_BY_ATTR       Step Search with Process, Scenario, Step, Doc. Attributes   .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I FIND_STEP_INSTANCES_BY_ATTR   Step Instance Search with Proc., Scen, Step, Doc. Attributes.
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I GET                           Determine Step Instance                                     .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I GET_ATTACHMENTS               Determine All Attachments of Step                           .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I GET_DATA_CONTAINER            Determine Current Data Container Status                     .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I GET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Determine General Attributes for Step Object                .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I GET_PARENT_SCENARIO           Determine Associated Scenario Object                        .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I READ_ATTACHMENT               Read Attachment (Content and Attributes)                    .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I SET_DATA_CONTAINER            Specify Current Data Container Status                       .
IF_HRASR00_STEP                I SET_GENERAL_ATTRIBUTES        Determine General Attributes for Step Object                .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_DELETE_COMPUTATIONS       PAD-Specific Logic for Delete                               .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_INITIAL_COMPUTATIONS      PAD-Specific Processing for Record Creation                 .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_INSERT_COMPUTATIONS       PAD-Specific Logic for Insert                               .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_MODIFY_COMPUTATIONS       PAD-Specific Logic for Modify                               .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_READ_COMPUTATIONS         PAD-Specific Single Record Processing After Read            .
IF_HRBAS_1001_PADNNN           I PAD_REQUIRED_FIELDS           Fill PADnnn Required Fields                                 .
IF_HRBAS_ADDITIONAL_BUFFER     I ADDITIONAL_UPDATE             Additional Update                                           .
IF_HRBAS_ADDITIONAL_UPDATE     I UPDATE                        Execute update                                              .
IF_HRBAS_AUTHORIZATION         I CHECK_AUTHORIZATION           HRBAS Authorization Check                                   .
IF_HRBAS_AUTHORIZATION         I CHECK_DUTY_RELAT              Checks Whether an Essential Relationship Is Required        .
IF_HRBAS_BUFFER_CONTROL        I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Adopt Speculatively Executed Operations                     .
IF_HRBAS_BUFFER_CONTROL        I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Discard Speculatively Executed Operations                   .
IF_HRBAS_BUFFER_CONTROL        I FLUSH                         Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_HRBAS_BUFFER_CONTROL        I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRBAS_BUFFER_CONTROL        I START_TRIAL                   Execute Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRBAS_CDOC_EVENT_HANDLER    I GET_EVENT_HANDLER_INSTANCE    Delivers an Instance of an Event Handler                    .
IF_HRBAS_CDOC_HANDLER          I ADD_CHANGEDOC_VALUES          Transfer application data to Change Documents               .
IF_HRBAS_CDOC_HANDLER          I GET_CHANGEDOC_OBJECT_NAME     Delivers name of the document object for an infotype        .
IF_HRBAS_CDOC_HANDLER          I WRITE_CHANGE_DOCUMENTS        Create change documents for existing application data       .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I ACTION                        Any Infotype Operation                                      .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I DELETE                        Delete infotype record                                      .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I GET_INFTY_CONTAINER           Create New Infotype Records                                 .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I MODIFY                        Change Infotype Record (Changes to Key Allowed)             .
IF_HRBAS_DISPATCH_BL           I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRBAS_EXT_RELAT_READ        I READ_RELAT                    Reading of Relationships for HR Objects (RHDB)              .
IF_HRBAS_EXT_RELAT_READ        I READ_RELAT_EXT                Reading of Relationships for Objects (RHDB)                 .
IF_HRBAS_EXT_RELAT_READ        I READ_RELAT_STRU               Reading of Relationships for Organizational Structures RHAS .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Adopt Speculatively Executed Operations                     .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Discard Speculatively Executed Operations                   .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I POST_FLUSH                    Write to Database After Buffer                              .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I PRE_FLUSH                     Write to Database Before Buffer                             .
IF_HRBAS_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION I START_TRIAL                   Execute Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRBAS_GENERIC_UPDATE        I DELETE                        Delete Infotype Data                                        .
IF_HRBAS_GENERIC_UPDATE        I INSERT                        Add Infotype Data                                           .
IF_HRBAS_GENERIC_UPDATE        I MODIFY                        Change Infotype Data                                        .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GENERIC_BL_ACTION_COMPUTATION Generic Business Logic for Specific Actions                 .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GENERIC_BL_DELETE_COMPUTATION Generic BL for Deletion of Infotype Record                  .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GENERIC_BL_INITIAL_COMPUTATIONGeneric BL for Initialization of a New Infotype Record      .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GENERIC_BL_INSERT_COMPUTATION Generic BL for Creation of a New Infotype Record            .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GENERIC_BL_MODIFY_COMPUTATION Generic BL for Changes to an Infotype Record                .
IF_HRBAS_GEN_BL_COMPUTATION    I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers an Instance of Generic Business Logic              .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I ACTION                        Any Infotype Operation                                      .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I DELETE                        Delete infotype record                                      .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I GET_INFTY_CONTAINER           Create New Infotype Records (GUI Layer)                     .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I MODIFY                        Change Infotype Record (Changes to Key Allowed)             .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I POST_READ                     Single Record Processing After Read                         .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL              I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_ACTION_COMPUTATION         Business Logic for Specific Actions                         .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_DELETE_COMPUTATION         Business Logic for Deletion of an Infotype Record           .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_INITIAL_COMPUTATION        Business Logic for Initialization of a New Infotype Record  .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_INSERT_COMPUTATION         Business Logic for Creation of a New Infotype Record        .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_MODIFY_COMPUTATION         Business Logic for Changes to an Infotype Record            .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I BL_READ_COMPUTATION           Business Logic (Single Record Processing) After Read        .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BL_COMPUTATION  I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers an Instance of the Infotype-Specific BL            .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BUFFER          I DELETE                        Delete Infotype Record                                      .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BUFFER          I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BUFFER          I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_BUFFER          I UPDATE                        Change an Infotype Record (Changes to Key Not Allowed)      .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER       I CLONE                         Delivers a Deep Copy                                        .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER       I HAS_DIFFERENT_DATA            Tests for Differences in Data Section                       .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER       I MODIFY_INFOTYPE_LOGIC         Set Infotype Logic                                          .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER       I MODIFY_KEY                    Creation of a Copy with Changed Key                         .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA  I HRIADMIN                      Delivers HRIADMIN                                           .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA  I MODIFY_HRIADMIN               Creation of a Copy with Changed HRIADMIN                    .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA  I MODIFY_PNNNN                  Creation of a Copy with Changed Data                        .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA  I PNNNN_REF                     Delivers Reference to PNNN                                  .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DB    I READ                          Read Infotypes                                              .
IF_HRBAS_INFTY_CONTAINER_DB    I UPDATE                        Change Infotypes                                            .
IF_HRBAS_MESSAGE_HANDLER       I ADD_MESSAGE                   Transfer Message to Message Handler                         .
IF_HRBAS_OBJECT_OPERATIONS     I CHANGE_OBJECT_TIMEPERIOD      Change Object Period                                        .
IF_HRBAS_OBJECT_OPERATIONS     I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object                                               .
IF_HRBAS_OBJECT_OPERATIONS     I EXIST_OBJECT                  Check Whether Object Exists                                 .
IF_HRBAS_OBJECT_OPERATIONS     I HISTORICIZE_OBJECT            Create Historical Record of Object                          .
IF_HRBAS_OBJECT_OPERATIONS     I READ_OBJECT                   Read an Object                                              .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I GET_INITIAL_RECORD            Read Default Values                                         .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I INSERT                        Insert                                                      .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I MODIFY                        Change                                                      .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I READ                          Read Multiple Records and Table Sections                    .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I READ_BY_HRIPKEY               Read One Specified Infotype Record                          .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS I READ_SINGLE                   Read an Infotype Record                                     .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_BUFFER I DELETE                        Delete Infotype Record                                      .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_BUFFER I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_BUFFER I READ                          Read Infotype Records                                       .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_BUFFER I UPDATE                        Change an Infotype Record (Changes to Key Not Allowed)      .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_DB     I READ                          Read Infotypes (Result Is Flat, No Container)               .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_READ_INFOTYPE   I READ                          Read Infotype Records                                       .
IF_HRBAS_PLAIN_READ_INFOTYPE   I READ_1001                     Read Infotype 1001 (Internal and External Relationships)    .
IF_HRBAS_PQ_CONVERSION         I GET_QNNNN                     Deliver Reference to Q Structure of an Infotype             .
IF_HRBAS_PQ_CONVERSION         I PNNNN_TO_QNNNN                Convert P to Q                                              .
IF_HRBAS_PQ_CONVERSION         I QNNNN_TO_PNNNN                Convert Q to P                                              .
IF_HRBAS_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ                          Read HRBAS Infotype Records                                 .
IF_HRBAS_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ_1001                     Read Infotype 1001 (Internal and External Relationships)    .
IF_HRBAS_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ_PLAIN                    Read HRBAS Infotype Records                                 .
IF_HRBAS_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ_PLAIN_1001               Read Infotype 1001 (Internal and External Relationships)    .
IF_HRBAS_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ_TRANSLATIONS             Reads Translations for an Infotype Record                   .
IF_HRBAS_TINFTY_CONTAINER_DATA I HRTNNNN_REF                   Delivers Reference to Table Section for Table Infotypes     .
IF_HRBAS_TINFTY_CONTAINER_DATA I MODIFY_HRTNNNN                Creation of a Copy with Modified Table Section              .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I DELETE_IT_ENTRY               Delete Entries of All Assignments in IT Tables              .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_ALL_BAREA                 Get All Benefit Areas of a Person                           .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_ALL_PERNR                 Get All PERNOs of a Person                                  .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_CONSECUTIVE_MAIN_CONTRACT Get Next Main Personnel Assignment for Same Benefit Area    .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_CRT_SUM                   Get CRT Sum over Assignments                                .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_IT_SUM                    Get IT Sum over Assignments                                 .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_LAST_CONTR                Get Last Contribution                                       .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_PERS_CRT_SUM              Get a Sum over CRT of All Assignments of a Person           .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I GET_RT_SUM                    Get It Sum for Assignments Grouped for Benefit Calculation  .
IF_HRBEN_CE_PAYROLL_SERVICES   I READ_IT_LINE                  Read An Entry of IT Table                                   .
IF_HRBEN_GROUPING_CONTEXT      I GET_CONTEXT                   Definition of Context                                       .
IF_HRBEN_GROUPING_CONTEXT      I GET_INSTANCE                  Create Instance for Context                                 .
IF_HRCCE_GROUPING_RULE         I GET_ALL_VALUES                Get all possible values returned by the grouping rule       .
IF_HRCCE_GROUPING_RULE         I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance                                                .
IF_HRCCE_GROUPING_RULE         I GET_SEARCH_HELP               Get the search help to select a value                       .
IF_HRCCE_GROUPING_RULE         I GET_TEXT_VALUE                Get text corresponding to a grouping value                  .
IF_HRCCE_GROUPING_RULE         I GET_VALUES_BY_PERNR           Get grouping values between two dates for a personnel assig .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I PROPOSE_MOLGA_FOR_ITEM        Propose molga for reading items                             .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I READ_AFIELD_VALUE_FROM_PRELP  Read addtional field value from buffer                      .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I READ_FIELD_VALUE_FROM_PRELP   Read DDIC values from buffer                                .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I READ_INFO_BUFFER              Read infotype information into buffer                       .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I READ_INFO_CATEGORY            Read information categories                                 .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_CATALOG   I READ_INFO_ITEM                Read information items                                      .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_READER    I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_READER    I READ_PERNR_TEXT               Read pernr description text                                 .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_READER    I READ_PERNR_TEXT_BY_PERSONID   Read pernr text table by Personid                           .
IF_HRCCE_PERSON_INFO_READER    I READ_PERNR_TEXT_TAB           Read pernr text table by pernr                              .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTRLR_TABLE   I EVALUATE_FIELDCATALOG         Evaluate fieldcatalog                                       .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTRLR_TABLE   I EVALUATE_TABLE_ATTRIBUTES     Evaluate attributes of a table                              .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTRLR_TABLE   I EVALUATE_TOOLBAR              Evaluate toolbar                                            .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTRLR_TREE    I EVALUATE_TOOLBAR              Evaluate toolbar                                            .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTRLR_TREE    I EVALUATE_TREEFLDCATALOG       Evaluate tree field catalog                                 .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTROLLER      I HANDLE_APPLICATION_EVENT      Handle job pricing application event                        .
IF_HRECM00_BSP_CONTROLLER_BDG  I HANDLE_APPLICATION_EVENT      Handle budgeting application event                          .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I DELETE                        Delete object from database                                 .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I DEQUEUE                       Unlock object                                               .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I ENQUEUE                       Lock object                                                 .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I SET_DELETE_FLAG               Mark object to remember for delete                          .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I SET_UPDATE_FLAG               Mark object to remember for update                          .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I START_DELETE                  Start Delete process                                        .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I START_UPDATE                  Start Update process                                        .
IF_HRECM00_LISTENER            I UPDATE                        Update object to database                                   .
IF_HRECM00_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_MESSAGE                   Transfer Message to Message Handler                         .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I CREATE_CONTACT                Create New Contact                                          .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I CREATE_FOLLOWUP               Create New Follow-Up                                        .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I CREATE_NOTE                   Create New Note                                             .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I DELETE                        Deletes Activity                                            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I DEQUEUE                       Unlocks Activity Explicitly                                 .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I ENQUEUE                       Locks Activity                                              .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Output All Attributes Acc. Attribute Structure              .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_CHILDREN                  Transfer All Subobjects to GenIL Container                  .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_CONTACTS                  Output All Contacts                                         .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_DOCUMENTS                 Output All Documents                                        .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_EMPLOYEE                  Output Employee                                             .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_FOLLOWUPS                 Output All Follow-Ups                                       .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_GUID                      Output Activity GUID = Case GUID                            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_LOG                       Log Output                                                  .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I GET_NOTES                     Output All Notes                                            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I MODIFY_ATTRIBUTES             Change Activity Attributes                                  .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I MODIFY_CHILDREN               Transfer All Modified Subobjects                            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I MODIFY_LAST_CONTACT           Change Last Contact                                         .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I MODIFY_LAST_NOTE              Change Last Note, If Own                                    .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I SAVE                          Saves Activity                                              .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I SEARCH                        Search Method for BOL Query Using FIND_CASES_BY_ATTR_RANGES .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY              I SET_DOCUMENT                  Add Document                                                .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_CHILD        I GET_ACTIVITY_GUID             Output Activity GUID = Case GUID                            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_CHILD        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Output All Attributes Acc. Attribute Structure              .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_CHILD        I GET_GUID                      Output Child GUID                                           .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_ACT_PROFILE               Output Activity Profile                                     .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_CATEGORIES                Provide Categories                                          .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_CHANNELS                  Provide Communication Channels                              .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_FOLLOWUP_PROCESSORS       Provide Follow-Up Processor per Follow-Up Reason            .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_FOLLOWUP_REASONS          Provide Follow-Up Reaons                                    .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_ICPROFILE                 Output IC Profile                                           .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_MAX_HITS                  Output Maximum Number of Records for Search                 .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_PRIORITIES                Provide Priorities                                          .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_STATUS                    Provide Valid Successor Status per Status                   .
IF_HREIC_ACTIVITY_SERVICE      I GET_SUBCATEGORIES             Provide Subcategories per Category                          .
IF_HREIC_EMPLOYEESEARCH        I ADJUST_PHONE_NUMBER           Change Phone Number for Reading Infotype 0105               .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I ADD_DD_FLAVOR                 Insert Drag and Drop Flavor                                 .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I ADD_OTYPE                     Register Object Type                                        .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I APPEND_TO_TOOLBAR             Add Application-Specific Functions to Global Toolbar        .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I CHECK_PERMISSIONS_FOR_OBJECTS CHECK_PERMISSIONS_FOR_OBJECTS                               .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I DETAIL_AREA_COLLAPSED         Actions after Hiding Overview Area                          .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I DETAIL_AREA_EXPANDED          Actions after Expanding Overview Area                       .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I FILTER_APPLC_OBJECTS          Filter from a Quantity Objects Permitted for the Application.
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I GET_CT_MENU                   Procure Application-Specific Context Menu                   .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I GET_OVERVIEW_DATA_CHANGED     Was Data Changed?                                           .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I OVERVIEW_AREA_COLLAPSED       Actions after Hiding Overview Area                          .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I OVERVIEW_AREA_EXPANDED        Actions after Expanding Overview Area                       .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I PREPARE_APPLC_OBJECTS         Application-Specific Preprocessing of Objects               .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I PROCESS_ADD_OBJECTS           Insert Data for Objects                                     .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I PROCESS_NEW_OBJECTS           Process New Objects                                         .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC             I REFRESH                       Reselect Details for Selected Objects                       .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I ADD_APPLC                     Insert Application                                          .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I ADD_OBJECTS                   Add Objects                                                 .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I COLLAPSE_DETAIL_AREA          Hide Detail Area                                            .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I COLLAPSE_OVERVIEW_AREA        Hide Overview Area                                          .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I COLLAPSE_TOOLBAR_AREA         Hide Toolbar Area                                           .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I EXPAND_DETAIL_AREA            Expand Detail Area                                          .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I EXPAND_OVERVIEW_AREA          Expand Overview Area                                        .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I EXPAND_TOOLBAR_AREA           Expand Toolbar Area                                         .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I REFRESH                       Reconstruct                                                 .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I REMOVE_OBJECTS                Remove objects                                              .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I SET_APPLC_SUPPLY              Transfer Amount to Selectable Views                         .
IF_HRFPM_AWB_APPLC_HOST        I SET_DETAIL_AREA_CAPTION       Set Text for Detail Area                                    .
IF_HRFPM_BPREP_ORG_STRUC       I MODIFY_EXTRACTION_DATA        Change in Extraction Data                                   .
IF_HRFPM_CHART_HANDLER         I DYNAMIC_COLLECT               Summarize Output Table                                      .
IF_HRFPM_CHART_HANDLER         I GET_CHART                     Create Output Table                                         .
IF_HRFPM_CHART_HANDLER         I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_HRFPM_CHART_HANDLER         I REFRESH_CHART                 Create Output Table                                         .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I ASSIGNMENT_TYPE               Assignment Status                                           .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I COLI                          Cost of Living Index                                        .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I COLI_DATE                     COLI Date Rate                                              .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I CONVERT_CURRENCY              Convert an amount into requested currency                   .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I EXCHANGE_DATE                 Determine Date for Exchange Calculations                    .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I EXCHANGE_RATE                 Exchange Rate Home Country to Host Country                  .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I FAMILY_STATUS                 Family Status                                               .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I GET_BASE_CPI_TABLE            Obsolete! Use GET_CPI_CALC_DETAILS                          .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I GET_DERIVED_CPI_TABLE         Obsolete! Use GET_CPI_CALC_DETAILS                          .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I HOME_COUNTRY                  Home Country                                                .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I HOME_CURRENCY                 Home Currency                                               .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I HOST_COUNTRY                  Host Country                                                .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I HOST_CURRENCY                 Host Currency                                               .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I READ_SINGLE_P0706             Read single record for IT0706                               .
IF_HRGE_COMP_PACK_ATTRIBUTE    I SENDING_COUNTRY               Sending Country                                             .
IF_HRGE_CPACK_CPI_DETAILS      I GET_CPI_CALC_DETAILS          Get the calculation details of a CPI                        .
IF_HRGE_CPACK_SERVICES         I CHECK_CPI_ELIGIBILITY         Check if a CPI is eligible                                  .
IF_HRGE_CPACK_SERVICES         I GET_OVERWRITTEN_VALUE         Provide overwritten values                                  .
IF_HRGE_DOCUMENT               I CLOSE                         Close the document                                          .
IF_HRGE_DOCUMENT               I OPEN                          Open the document                                           .
IF_HRGE_DOCUMENT               I PRINT                         Print the document                                          .
IF_HRGE_DOCUMENT               I SAVE                          Save the document                                           .
IF_HRGE_GECCO_SELECTION        I SET_SELECTION                 Set the selection                                           .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I ASSIGNMENT_TYPE               Get Assignment Type                                         .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I ASSIGN_PERCENTAGE             Get employment percentage                                   .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I CAREER_SPONSOR                Get Career Sponsor                                          .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I DEPENDANTS                    Get the dependents (wife, children ...)                     .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I DURATION                      Get duration of the assignment                              .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I FAMILY_STATUS                 Get Family Status                                           .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOME_BTRTL                    Personnel subarea of the home assignment                    .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOME_COUNTRY                  Get Home country                                            .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOME_PERNR                    Personnel Number of the home assignment                     .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOME_POSITION                 Position of the home assignment                             .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOME_WERKS                    Personnel area of the home assignment                       .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOST_BTRTL                    Personnel subarea of the host assignment                    .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOST_COUNTRY                  Get Host Country                                            .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOST_PERNR                    Personnel Number of the host assignment                     .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOST_POSITION                 Position of the host assignment                             .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I HOST_WERKS                    Personnel area of the host assignment                       .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I INTL_HR_ADMIN                 Get international HR administrator                          .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I NO_OF_DEPENDANTS              Determine number of accompanying dependants                 .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I PROMOTION_ON_TRANSFER         Get Promotion on Transfer                                   .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I SENDING_COUNTRY               Get Sending Country                                         .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I SENDING_PERNR                 Personnel Number of the sending assignment                  .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I START_DATE                    Get start date                                              .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I STATUS_HOME                   Get Status Home Country                                     .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I STATUS_HOST                   Get Status Host Country                                     .
IF_HRGE_GLOBAL_ATTRIBUTES      I TERMINATION_DATE              Get start date                                              .
IF_HRGE_MESSAGE_HANDLER        I ADD_PERNR_MESSAGE             Add Message with Pers No.                                   .
IF_HRGE_MESSAGE_HANDLER        I SET_PERNR                     Set Pers. No.                                               .
IF_HRGE_OFFER_LETTER           I LOAD_DATA                     Load master data in the document                            .
IF_HRGE_OFFER_LETTER           I SAVE_ON_GLOB_ASS              Save the document on the global assignment                  .
IF_HRGE_OS_SELECTION           I SET_SELECTION                 Set the selection                                           .
IF_HRPADIT_TABLE_READER_PY     I GET_RESULT                    Get the result                                              .
IF_HRPADIT_TABLE_READER_PY     I READ_TABLE                    Read infotype                                               .
IF_HRPADIT_TABLE_READER_PY     I SET_RULE                      Set rule                                                    .
IF_HRPAYBE_DAQ_MISC_SRD        I GET_RISK_DATES                Get risk starting and end date                              .
IF_HRPAYBE_DAQ_MISC_SRD        I SET_RISK_DATES                Set risk starting and end date                              .
IF_HRPAYCH_LFORM               I GET_FORM_GROUP                Determine Form Group                                        .
IF_HRPAYCH_LFORM               I GET_OUTPUT_LANGUAGE           Determine Output Langauge                                   .
IF_HRPAYCH_LFORM               I PRINT                         Print Form                                                  .
IF_HRPAYCH_LIST_ENTRY          I GET_OUTPUT_LINE               Determine Output Line                                       .
IF_HRPAYCH_LIST_ENTRY          I GET_OUTPUT_TYPE               Determine Dictionary Type of the Output Line                .
IF_HRPAYCH_MESSAGE_CONTAINER   I GET_MESSAGES                  Determine error messages                                    .
IF_HRPAYCH_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_MESSAGE                   Transfer Message to Message Handler                         .
IF_HRPAYCH_MULTIPLE_INSTANCE   I GET_BUSINESS_KEY              Determines the (Business) Key                               .
IF_HRPAYCH_MULTIPLE_INSTANCE   I PROCESS_INSTANCE              Processing of a Registered Instance by the Factory          .
IF_HRPAYCH_PAY_RESULTS_PROCESS I PROCESS_PAYROLL_RESULT        Process Payroll Results                                     .
IF_HRPAYCH_SAPSCRIPT           I GET_OUTPUT_LANGUAGE           Determine Output Langauge                                   .
IF_HRPAYCH_SAPSCRIPT           I GET_OUTPUT_PROGRAM            Determine Program for Output Structure                      .
IF_HRPAYCH_SAPSCRIPT           I PRINT                         Print SAPScript                                             .
IF_HRPAYCH_SAPSCRIPT           I SET_OUTPUT_STRUCTURE          Set Output Structure in the Print Program                   .
IF_HRPAYCH_SMARTFORM           I PRINT                         Print Smart Form                                            .
IF_HRPAYCH_SORTABLE            I CREATE_SORTFIELD              Create Sort Field                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_AT_SELECTION_SCREEN       Application: run at_selection_screen                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_END_OF_SELECTION          Application: End of selection                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_FILL_APP_MISC             Application: fill app misc                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_GET_PERNR                 Application: Get Pernr                                      .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_INITIALIZE                Application: Initialize                                     .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I APP_INIT_EMPLOYEE             Application: Init employee                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN           Run at_selection_screen                                     .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I CHANGE_FORM                   Change Unified reporting form                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I GET_APP_MISC                  Get application misc                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I GET_EMPLOYEE                  Get employee class                                          .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I PROC_END_OF_SELECTION         Run END-OF-SELECTION                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I PROC_GET_PERNR                Run GET PERNR                                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I PROC_INIT_EMPLOYEE            Init employee                                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I PROC_START_OF_SELECTION       Run START-OF-SELECTION                                      .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I SET_APP_MISC                  Set application misc                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CONTROLLER     I SET_EMPLOYEE                  Set employee class                                          .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I GET_CORR_FROM_FILE            GET_CORR_FROM_FILE                                          .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I GET_CORR_PER_PERSON           GET_CORR_PER_PERSON                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I GET_CORR_STATUS_PER_PERSON    GET_CORR_STATUS_PER_PERSON                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I GET_TEMSE_NAME                GET TEMSE NAME                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I SET_CORR_FROM_FILE            SET_CORR_FROM_FILE                                          .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I SET_CORR_STATUS_PER_PERSON    SET_CORR_STATUS_PER_PERSON                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I SET_TEMSE_NAME                SET TEMSE NAME                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I SET_TYPRO_AND_STATS           SET_TYPRO_AND_STATS                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CORR_HANDLER   I WRITE_CORR_FILE_TO_TEMSE      corr file 2 temse                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I DETERMINE_DAQ_CUSTOMIZING     Determine the DAQ customizing                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUB                Get table T5ITUB                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUD                Get table T5ITUD                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUF                Get table T5ITUF                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUG                Get table T5ITUG                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUP                Get table T5ITUP                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I GET_TAB_T5ITUS                Get table T5ITUS                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUB                   Read table T5ITUB                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUD                   Read table T5ITUD                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUF                   Read table T5ITUF                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUG                   Read table T5ITUG                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUP                   Read table T5ITUP                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_CUSTOMIZING    I READ_T5ITUS                   Read table T5ITUS                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_DAQ_ENGINE     I ADD_FIELD                     ADD_FIELD                                                   .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_DAQ_ENGINE     I ADD_SECTN                     ADD_SECTN                                                   .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_DAQ_ENGINE     I INIT                          INIT                                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_DAQ_ENGINE     I RUN                           RUN                                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_DAQ_ENGINE     I SET_FORM                      SET_FORM                                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I INIT                          INIT                                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I RUN_ALL_INIT_STEP             RUN_ALL_INIT_STEP                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I RUN_ALL_PERNR_STEP            RUN_ALL_PERNR_STEP                                          .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I RUN_BUILD_VAR_TABLE_STEP      RUN_BUILD_VAR_TABLE_STEP                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I RUN_PERNR_INIT_STEP           RUN_PERNR_INIT_STEP                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_PROC_ENGINE    I RUN_PERNR_STEP                RUN_PERNR_STEP                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_SEQUENCE       I GET_NEXT_SEQNO                Next sequence number                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_SEQUENCE       I GET_SEQNO_FOR_FIELD           Part of the current number for a field                      .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_SEQUENCE       I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_SEQUENCE       I RESET                         Reset                                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_SEQUENCE       I SET_SEQNO                     Set sequence number                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I APPEND_TABLE_PER_PERSON       APPEND_TABLE_PER_PERSON                                     .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I CHECK_EMPTY_TABLE             Check if the global vartab is empty                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I DELETE_TABLES                 Delete all the table handler's tables                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I DELETE_TABLE_PER_PERSON       Delete the vartab of a CID                                  .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_PERNR_LIST                get list of pernr for viewer                                .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_PERNR_TABLE               Get Pern table                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_SELECTED_VARTAB           Get selected vartab                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_STATUS_PER_PERSON         GET_STATUS_PER_PERSON                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_TABLE                     GET_TABLE                                                   .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I GET_TABLE_PER_PERSON          GET_TABLE_PER_PERSON                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I ITERATOR                      ITERATOR                                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I READ_TABLE_FROM_TEMSE         READ_TABLE_FROM_TEMSE                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I RESET                         reset table handler                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I SET_PERNR_TABLE               Set Pern table                                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I SET_STATUS_PER_PERSON         SET_STATUS_PER_PERSON                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I SET_TABLE                     SET_TABLE                                                   .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I SET_TABLE_PER_PERSON          SET_TABLE_PER_PERSON                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I SET_TYPRO_AND_STATS           set typro and stats                                         .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I UPDATE_STATUS_DB              UPDATE_STATUS_DB                                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_FORM_TABLE_HANDLER  I WRITE_TABLE_TO_TEMSE          WRITE_TABLE_TO_TEMSE                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_ITERATOR            I FIRST                         FIRST                                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_ITERATOR            I HAS_NEXT                      HAS_NEXT                                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_ITERATOR            I NEXT                          NEXT                                                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGABLE            I GET_LOG                       GET_LOG                                                     .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGABLE            I GET_LOGGING                   GET_LOGGING                                                 .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGABLE            I SET_LOG                       SET_LOG                                                     .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGABLE            I SET_LOGGING                   SET_LOGGING                                                 .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I ADD_PUSHBUTTON                Add a pushbutton to the ALV                                 .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I APPEND_T100_MESSAGE           Append a T100 Msg                                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I DISPLAY_LOG                   Display the log                                             .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I GET_GLOBAL_STATS              Get global message statistics                               .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I GET_PERNR_STATS               Get message statistics for personnel                        .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I SET_PERNR_TEXT                Set text for a personnel number                             .
IF_HRPAYIT_LOGGER              I TOGGLE_PUSHBUTTON             Toggle active/inactive state of a pushbutton                .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I GET_VIEWABLE                  get a viewable object                                       .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I MARK_ALL                      mark all the objects of a list                              .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I MARK_BLOCK                    mark a block of objects in a list                           .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I MARK_SINGLE                   mark an object of a list                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I SHOW                          show the viewable object                                    .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I SHOW_LIST                     show a list of objects                                      .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I UNMARK_ALL                    unmark all the objects of a list                            .
IF_HRPAYIT_VIEWABLE            I VIEW_VARTAB                   view the vartab in an alv list                              .
IF_HRPAYJP_ABSTRACT_FILEREC    I SET_FIELD                     Add a field into a record of a file                         .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I CHECK_FACTORING_RELEVANT      check whether wagetype relevant                             .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I CHECK_KIJUN_GAI               check whether kijun gai or kijun nai                        .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I GET_CUMULATION_CLASS          get cumulation class                                        .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance                                                .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I GET_PROCESSING_CLASS          get processing class                                        .
IF_HRPAYJP_SK_READ_WT_ATTRIB   I GET_WAGETYPE_GROUPING         get wagetype grouping                                       .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I CREATE_TEMSE                  Creates TemSe file                                          .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I DISPLAY_ALV_GRID              Shows ALV Grid                                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I FILL_ALV_DETAIL_TAB           Fills detailed ALV list                                     .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I FILL_ALV_TAB                  Fills ALV list                                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I FILL_TEMSE                    Fills in TemSe file lines                                   .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_ALV_FIELD_CAT             Obtains field catalog for ALV list                          .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_COMPANY_DATA              Obtains company data                                        .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_END_DATE                  End date of declaration period                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_ERRORS                    Obtains error list                                          .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_FORMS                     Obtains created declaration                                 .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_FORM_SECTION              Obtains declaration basic data                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_GEN_DATE                  Obtains declaration generation date                         .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_PAYROLL_COMP              Obtains required payroll table                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_REFERENCE_SECTION         Obtains reference                                           .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_RFC                       Obtains RFC                                                 .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I GET_START_DATE                Declaration period start date                               .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I INSTANTIATE_FORM              Submits the corresponding DAQ declaration                   .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I PROCESS_EMPLOYEE              Employee prcssng                                            .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I PROCESS_EMPLOYEE_TABLES       Processes employer tables                                   .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I READ_T7MX01                   Reads additional company information                        .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I SET_SEL_PARAMS                Sets selection screen parameters                            .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_MISC            I SORT_ALV_TABLE                Assigns position and sorts ALV list table                   .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_SOSA            I GET_VALUES_WAGETYPES          Obtains wage type values                                    .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_SOSA            I SET_FORM_DATA                 Sets data of declaration in process                         .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_OCRSN                     Obtains special payroll reason                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_PAYID                     Obtains payroll ID for off-cycle payroll                    .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_PAYTY                     Obtains payroll type for off-cycle payroll                  .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_PAY_DATE                  Obtains payment date                                        .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_STATE                     Obtains process status                                      .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I GET_YEAR_MONTH                Obtains Year and month for process                          .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I SET_FORM_DATA                 Sets data for declaration in process                        .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_STAX            I SET_STATE                     Sets processed status                                       .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_OCRSN                     Obtains off-cycle payroll reason                            .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_PAYID                     Obtains off-cycle payroll ID                                .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_PAYTY                     Obtains off-cycle payroll type                              .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_PAY_DATE                  Obtains payment date                                        .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_TERMINATION_DATE_CLASS    Obtains payment date and termination type                   .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I GET_VALUES_WAGETYPES          Obtains wage type values                                    .
IF_HRPAYMX_DAQ_TERM            I SET_FORM_DATA                 Sets data of declaration in process                         .
IF_HRPA_ADDITIONAL_BUFFER      I ADDITIONAL_UPDATE             Additional Update                                           .
IF_HRPA_ADDITIONAL_UPDATE      I UPDATE                        Execute update                                              .
IF_HRPA_ALE_HANDLER            I FLUSH                         Transfer Buffer to Database                                 .
IF_HRPA_ALE_HANDLER            I IS_PERNR_MAINTAINABLE         Validation of Original System                               .
IF_HRPA_ALE_HANDLER            I WRITE_CHANGE_POINTER          Transfer ALE Change Pointer to Buffer                       .
IF_HRPA_BUFFER_CONTROL         I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Transfer Operations Performed as Trial                      .
IF_HRPA_BUFFER_CONTROL         I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Reject Operations Performed as Trial                        .
IF_HRPA_BUFFER_CONTROL         I FLUSH                         Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_HRPA_BUFFER_CONTROL         I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRPA_BUFFER_CONTROL         I START_TRIAL                   Perform Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Transfer Operations Performed as Trial                      .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Reject Operations Performed as Trial                        .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I POST_FLUSH                    Write to database after buffer                              .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I PRE_FLUSH                     Write to database before buffer                             .
IF_HRPA_FRAMEWORK_INTEGRATION  I START_TRIAL                   Perform Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRPA_INFOTYPE_CONTAINER     I GET_INSTANCE                  Create New Instance                                         .
IF_HRPA_INFOTYPE_CONTAINER     I READ                          Gets Container from Database                                .
IF_HRPA_INFOTYPE_CONTAINER     I UPDATE                        Changes or Deletes Container on Database                    .
IF_HRPA_INFOTYPE_OPERATION     I ACTION                        Any Infotype Operation                                      .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I ACTION                        Any Infotype Operation                                      .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I DELETE                        Delete infotype record                                      .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I GET_INFTY_CONTAINER           Create New Infotype Records (GUI Layer)                     .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I MODIFY                        Change an Infotype Record (Changes to Key Permitted)        .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I POST_READ                     Processing of Individual Records after Reading              .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_BL               I REGROUP                       Adjust to Changed Grouping Values                           .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER        I CLONE                         Returns a Deep Copy                                         .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER        I HAS_DIFFERENT_DATA            Tests for Differences in Data Part                          .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER        I MODIFY_KEY                    Create Copy with Changed Key                                .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER        I PSHD1                         Read PDHD1                                                  .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER        I VERSION_ID                    Determine (View) Version of Record                          .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_AUTHC  I HAS_DIFFERENT_DATA            Tests for Differences in Data Part                          .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_AUTHC  I IS_STAMPED_BY_USER            Tests for Last Changed By                                   .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_AUTHC  I MODIFY_USER_STAMP             Writes Change Stamp                                         .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_AUTHC  I SUBTY                         Gets Subtype for Authorization Check                        .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I FIELD_METADATA_TAB            Read Metadata for Fields                                    .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_DATA                   Create Copy with Changed Data                               .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_FIELD_METADATA_TAB     Change Metadata                                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_PREF                   Create Copy with Changed Data                               .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_PRIMARY_RECORD         Create Copy with Changed Data                               .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_SECONDARY_RECORD       Create Copy with Changed Data                               .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I MODIFY_TEXT_TAB               Change text                                                 .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I PREF                          Read Cost Assignment                                        .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I PRIMARY_RECORD_REF            Get Reference to Primary Record                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I SECONDARY_RECORD_REF          Get Reference to Secondary Record                           .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_DATA   I TEXT_TAB                      Read Text for Fields                                        .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_GROUP  I GROUPING_VALUE                Read Grouping Value                                         .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_GROUP  I SET_GROUPING_VALUE            Set Grouping Value                                          .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_CONTAINER_RETRO  I IS_RETROACTIVE_DIFFERENT      Tests for Differences Relevant to Retroactive Accounting    .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_LEGACY_ADAPTER   I CHECK_DELETE                  Checks Whether Delete Permitted                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_LEGACY_ADAPTER   I CHECK_INSERT                  Checks Whether Insert Permitted                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_LEGACY_ADAPTER   I CHECK_MODIFY                  Checks Whether Modify Permitted                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_LEGACY_ADAPTER   I INITIAL_COMPUTATION           Used to Fill A Record Initially                             .
IF_HRPA_INFTY_LEGACY_ADAPTER   I POST_READ                     Executed After Records Have Been Read                       .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I ACTION                        Any Infotype Operation                                      .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Transfer Operations Performed as Trial                      .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I DELETE                        Delete infotype record                                      .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Reject Operations Performed as Trial                        .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I FLUSH                         Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I GET_INFTY_CONTAINER           Create New Infotype Records                                 .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I MODIFY                        Change an Infotype Record (Changes to Key Permitted)        .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I REGROUP                       Repair Grouped Infotypes                                    .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BL          I START_TRIAL                   Perform Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I APPROVE_TRIAL                 Transfer Operations Performed as Trial                      .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I DELETE                        Delete infotype record                                      .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I DISCARD_TRIAL                 Reject Operations Performed as Trial                        .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I FLUSH                         Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I INITIALIZE                    Delete (Write) Buffer                                       .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I INSERT                        Insert an Infotype Record                                   .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I START_TRIAL                   Perform Operations Speculatively                            .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_BUFFER      I UPDATE                        Change Infotype Record (Changes to Key Not Permitted)       .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_DB          I READ                          Read Infotype Data                                          .
IF_HRPA_MASTERDATA_DB          I UPDATE                        Change Infotype Data                                        .
IF_HRPA_MESSAGE_HANDLER        I ADD_MESSAGE                   Transfer Message to Message Handler                         .
IF_HRPA_PAITF_READ             I READ                          Read Access to PA ITF                                       .
IF_HRPA_PERNR_INFTY_XSS        I SET_BEGDA                     Set the date starting which infotype records must be set    .
IF_HRPA_PERNR_INFTY_XSS        I SET_SUBTY                     Set the supplied Subtypes for XSS Master Data Access Adapter.
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I GET_INITIAL_RECORD            Read Default Values                                         .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I INSERT                        Insert                                                      .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I MODIFY                        Change                                                      .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I READ                          Reading Several Primary Records                             .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I READ_BY_PSKEY                 Read One Specific Infotype Record                           .
IF_HRPA_PLAIN_INFOTYPE_ACCESS  I READ_SINGLE                   Read an Infotype Record                                     .
IF_HRPA_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ                          Read Several Records of an Infotype                         .
IF_HRPA_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_SINGLE                   Read Individual Infotype Record                             .
IF_HRPA_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_TEXT                     Reading Infotype Texts                                      .
IF_HRPA_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_WIDE                     Read Inclusive Secondary Records and Cost Assignment Data   .
IF_HRPA_READ_TIMECONSTRAINT    I CHECK_ADMISSIBILITY           Eligibility check                                           .
IF_HRPA_READ_TIMECONSTRAINT    I COMPUTE_TIMECONSTRAINT        Determine Time Constraint                                   .
IF_HRPA_RETRO_OVERWRITE        I RESET_DATES                   Delete/Reset Dates                                          .
IF_HRPA_RETRO_OVERWRITE        I SET_DATES                     Set Dates Relevant for Retroactive Accounting               .
IF_HRPA_RETRO_TRIGGER          I TRIGGER_RETRO                 Check and Trigger Retroactive Accounting                    .
IF_HRPA_STANDARD_CONVERSIONS   I INPUT_CONVERSION              Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Structure        .
IF_HRPA_STANDARD_CONVERSIONS   I INPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION        Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Repeat Structure .
IF_HRPA_STANDARD_CONVERSIONS   I OUTPUT_CONVERSION             Conversion of Infotype Structure to Screen Structure        .
IF_HRPA_STANDARD_CONVERSIONS   I OUTPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION       Conversion of Infotype Repeat Structure to Screen Structure .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I FILL_HELP_VALUES              Fill Value Help                                             .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I INITIALIZE                    Addition to Constructor                                     .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I INPUT_CONVERSION              Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Structure        .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I INPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION        Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Repeat Structure .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I OUTPUT_CONVERSION             Conversion of Infotype Structure to Screen Structure        .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_ADVANCED    I OUTPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION       Conversion of Infotype Repeat Structure to Screen Structure .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I FILL_HELP_VALUES              Fill Value Help                                             .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I INITIALIZE                    Addition to Constructor                                     .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I INPUT_CONVERSION              Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Structure        .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I INPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION        Conversion of Screen Structure to Infotype Repeat Structure .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I OUTPUT_CONVERSION             Conversion of Infotype Structure to Screen Structure        .
IF_HRPA_UI_CONVERT_STANDARD    I OUTPUT_TABLE_CONVERSION       Conversion of Infotype Repeat Structure to Screen Structure .
IF_HRPA_WORKFLOW_HANDLER       I DELETE                        Trigger for Delete                                          .
IF_HRPA_WORKFLOW_HANDLER       I FLUSH                         Write Buffer to Database                                    .
IF_HRPA_WORKFLOW_HANDLER       I INSERT                        Trigger for Insert                                          .
IF_HRPA_WORKFLOW_HANDLER       I UPDATE                        Trigger for Update                                          .
IF_HRPB15_TABLE_READER_PY      I GET_RESULT                    Get the result                                              .
IF_HRPB15_TABLE_READER_PY      I READ_TABLE                    Read infotype                                               .
IF_HRPB15_TABLE_READER_PY      I SET_RULE                      Set rule                                                    .
IF_HRPBSNO_NOTIF_SMART_FORMS   I CREATE_NOTIFICATION           Create Notification                                         .
IF_HRPBSNO_NOTIF_SMART_FORMS   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get the instance for creating of the notification           .
IF_HRPFD00_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_MESSAGE                   Insert error message                                        .
IF_HRPFD00_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_MESSAGE_TAB               Enter table of error messages                               .
IF_HRPIQ00AGGR_TOOL            I GET_ACADWORK_FOR_NODE         Set Academic Work                                           .
IF_HRPIQ00AGGR_TOOL            I GET_VALUES_FOR_NODE           Set Values                                                  .
IF_HRPIQ00BSPFRAME_COM         I DO_GET_DATA                   Data Collection                                             .
IF_HRPIQ00BSPFRAME_COM         I DO_INITIALIZATION             Initialize                                                  .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I APPEND_COHORTS                Add Main Cohorts and Subcohorts                             .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES             Attribute Changes for Cohort                                .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I CHANGE_CAPACITIES             Change Cohort Capacity                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I CHANGE_DESCRIPTION            Change Cohort Description                                   .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I CHANGE_PERIODS                Add and Delete Sessions of Offering                         .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I DELETE_CONTEXT_OBJECTS        Remove Context Objects                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I DELETE_STUDENTS               Remove Students from Cohort                                 .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I INSERT_CONTEXT_OBJECTS        Insert Context Objects                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I INSERT_STUDENTS               Add Students to Cohort                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I NEW_COHORT                    Create New Cohort                                           .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I NEW_CONTEXT                   Create New Context for Cohort                               .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I REMOVE_COHORTS                Remove Main Cohorts and Subcohorts                          .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_CAUD         I SAVE_COHORTS                  Save Cohorts                                                .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I CHECK_SAVING                  Check if Data is to be Saved                                .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GENERATE_TREE_FOR_COHORTS     Tree Structure for Cohorts at Runtime                       .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Output Attributes                                           .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_CAPACITY                  Output Cohort Capacity                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_CAPA_SUB_MAIN             Output Cohort Capacity for All Main Cohorts and Subcohorts  .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_COHORT_DATA               Read Additional Cohort and Student Data                     .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_COHORT_TEXT               Read Additional Cohort and Student Texts                    .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_CONTEXT_OBJECTS           Return Context Objects of Main Cohort                       .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_PERIODS                   Output Sessions of Offering for Cohort                      .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_STUDENTS_OF_ENTR_COHORT   Output Students of Main Cohort                              .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_TREE_OF_MOTHER_COHORTS    Output Cohort Tree Data                                     .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_QUERY        I GET_TREE_OF_SUB_COHORTS       Output Cohort Tree Data                                     .
IF_HRPIQ00COHORTS_TOOLS        I DISTRIBUTE_STUDENTS           Distribution of Students to Subcohorts                      .
IF_HRPIQ00MP_PROCESSOR         I PROCESS                       Execute Mass Processing                                     .
IF_HRPIQ00PDOBJECT             I CREATE_OBJECT                 New Object                                                  .
IF_HRPIQ00PDOBJECT             I GET_OBJECT                    Get Instance                                                .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_PROCESS      I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_PROCESS      I PROCESS                       Execute Progression                                         .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I CHECK_RESULT                  Check Progression Result                                    .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I GET_MB_SI2                    Read Module Bookings and Performance Index for Period       .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I GET_RESULT                    Determine Progression Result                                .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I GET_RESULTLIST                Get Result List                                             .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I GET_RESULT_HISTORY            Get Progression Result History                              .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I GET_RESULT_TEXT_FOR_PROGCVAR  Get Progression Description for Program Type                .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I INIT                          ABAP Object Initialization                                  .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I IS_RESULT_EXISTING            Check If a Progression Result Exists                        .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I PROCESS                       Execute Progression                                         .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I SET_OBJECT                    Set Object Before Reading                                   .
IF_HRPIQ00PROG_GR_RESULT       I SET_RESULT_HISTORY            Set Progression Results                                     .
IF_HRPIQ00REQUIREMENTS_APPL    I ADD_MESSAGE_TABLE             Add Message Table (BAPIRET2)                                .
IF_HRPIQ00REQUIREMENTS_APPL    I ADD_SYSTEM_MESSAGE            Add System Message                                          .
IF_HRPIQ00REQUIREMENTS_APPL    I GET_PLVAR                     Determine Plan Version                                      .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I GET_APPLICATION_INFO          Get Information on Application                              .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I GET_OKCODE                    Get OKCODE From Application                                 .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I GET_PARAM                     Get Parameters from Application                             .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I GET_PLVAR                     Get Plan Version from Application                           .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I SET_OKCODE                    Set OKCODE in Application                                   .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I SET_PARAM                     Set Paramters in Application                                .
IF_HRPIQ00SELMETHOD_APPIF      I SET_SUBSCREEN_DATA            Set Subscreen Including Information in Application          .
IF_HRPIQ00SI_TRANS_FILTER      I IS_MATCHING_TRANSCRIPT        Check for Matching Transcript                               .
IF_HRPS_PWE_PSCEN_EXIT         I CHECK_PSTAT_AFTER_INP         Exit in Proc Scen status screen after input                 .
IF_HRPS_PWE_PSCEN_EXIT         I INIT                          Initialization at the Process Scenario level                .
IF_HRPS_PWE_PSCEN_EXIT         I PERFORM_PS_FCODE              Perform function code processing at Proc scen level         .
IF_HRPS_PWE_PSCEN_EXIT         I SET_PSTAT_BEFORE_OUT          Exit in Proc Scen Status screen before output               .
IF_HRPS_PWE_SUBPS_EXIT         I CHECK_SUBPSTAT_AFTER_INP      Exit in Sub PS Status screen after input                    .
IF_HRPS_PWE_SUBPS_EXIT         I PERFORM_SUBPS_FCODE           Exit  for handling Sub Process Scenario function codes      .
IF_HRPS_PWE_SUBPS_EXIT         I SET_SUBPSTAT_BEFORE_OUT       Exit in Sub PS Status screen before output                  .
IF_HRPT_BLP_INFOTYPE           I GET_INFTY_CONTAINER           Create Initial Infotype Container                           .
IF_HRPT_BLP_INFOTYPE           I MAINTAIN                      Validate Infotype Record                                    .
IF_HRPT_BLP_INFOTYPE           I READ                          Reading Infotype Records                                    .
IF_HRPT_INFTY_PARENTCHILD_CONT I GET_CHILDS                    Get Child Records of Container                              .
IF_HRPT_INFTY_PARENTCHILD_CONT I MODIFY_CHILDS                 Change Child Records of Container                           .
IF_HRPT_TMWBUFFER_VERSION_CTRL I CREATE_VERSION                Create Version from Current State                           .
IF_HRPT_TMWBUFFER_VERSION_CTRL I FORGET_VERSION                Remove Version from Version Management                      .
IF_HRPT_TMWBUFFER_VERSION_CTRL I REVERT_VERSION                Retrieve and Remove Version                                 .
IF_HRPY_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ                          Read Several Records of an Infotype                         .
IF_HRPY_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_KEY                      Read an individual infotype record with key                 .
IF_HRPY_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_PREF                     Reads cost assignment for an infotype                       .
IF_HRPY_READ_INFOTYPE          I READ_SINGLE                   Read Individual Infotype Record                             .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_CNF_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_CNF_EXCHG         I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_CAND_OVRV_INFO            Get Info About Candidate Overview                           .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_HEADER_HROBJECT           Get Object for Header                                       .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_MPROC_PARAMS              Export Parameters (Mass Processing)                         .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_REQ_HROBJECT              Get Object of Requisition                                   .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_SPROC_PARAMS              Export Parameters (Individual Processing)                   .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I GET_TASK                      Import Task                                                 .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I HAS_ERROR                     Does Higher-Level Controller Contain Errors?                .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I SAVE_ATTACHMENTS              Save Attachments                                            .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I SET_HEADER_HROBJECT           Set Object for Header                                       .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I SET_MPROC_PARAMS              Import Parameters (Mass Processing)                         .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I SET_RETURN_MESSAGE            Set Return/Success Message                                  .
IF_HRRCF_ACT_PROC_EXCHG        I SET_SPROC_PARAMS              Import Parameters (Individual Processing)                   .
IF_HRRCF_AGENCY_EXCHG          I GET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_AGENCY_EXCHG          I GET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_AGENCY_EXCHG          I SET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_AGENCY_EXCHG          I SET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APPLN_SOURCE_EXCHG    I GET_PARAMS                    Read application source info                                .
IF_HRRCF_APPLN_SOURCE_EXCHG    I SET_PARAMS                    Set application source info                                 .
IF_HRRCF_APPLY_EXCHG           I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APPLY_EXCHG           I SET_CURRENT_PINST             Set Selected Job Posting                                    .
IF_HRRCF_APPLY_EXCHG           I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_EXT_EXCHG   I GET_PARAMS                    Get parameter from Parent Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_EXT_EXCHG   I SET_PARAMS                    Return Parameter to Parent Controller                       .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_EXT_SUB_EXC I GET_SUB_PARAMS                Parent Controller: Get parameter of subcontroller           .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_EXT_SUB_EXC I RESET_DATA                    Subcontroller: reset application data or attachments        .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_INT_SUB_EXC I GET_SUB_PARAMS                Parent Controller: Get parameter of subcontroller           .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_DATA_INT_SUB_EXC I RESET_DATA                    Subcontroller: reset application data or attachments        .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_EXCHG            I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_NEW_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APPL_NEW_EXCHG        I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_APP_E_EXT_EXCHG       I GET_APPLDATA_PARAMS           Controller appl_data_m.do: Get Parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_APP_E_EXT_EXCHG       I GET_DUPLICATION_PARAMS        Controller duplication.do: Get Parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_APP_E_EXT_EXCHG       I SET_APPLDATA_PARAMS           Controller appl_data_m.do: Set Parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_APP_E_EXT_EXCHG       I SET_DUPLICATION_PARAMS        Controller duplication.do: Set Parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_APP_E_INT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Controller appl_data_m.do: Get Parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_ATTACH_EXCHG          I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_ATTACH_EXCHG          I SET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_BRANCH_EXCHG          I GET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_BRANCH_EXCHG          I GET_PARAMS                    Get Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_BRANCH_EXCHG          I SET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_BRANCH_EXCHG          I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_BRNCH_MNT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Get Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_BRNCH_MNT_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_BTF_EDIT_EXCHG        I GET_DOC_CONT                  Gets Document Content of BTF Editor                         .
IF_HRRCF_BTF_EDIT_EXCHG        I SET_DOC_CONT                  Sets Document Content of BTF Editor                         .
IF_HRRCF_CAND_DEL_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CAND_DEL_EXCHG        I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CAND_SRCH_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CAND_SRCH_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_CREA_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_CREA_EXCHG       I GET_RESULT_LIST               Export Result List                                          .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_CREA_EXCHG       I SET_RESULT_LIST               Import Result List                                          .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_EXCHG            I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_LIST_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Get parameter from Parent Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_LIST_EXCHG       I REFRESH_LIST                  Indicator: update list of candidacies                       .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_LIST_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Give Parameter to Parent Controller                         .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_PROC_EXCHG       I GET_CDCY_LIST_PARAMS          Controller cdcy_list_m.do: Get parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_PROC_EXCHG       I GET_CDCY_SLCT_PARAMS          Controller cdcy_slct_m.do: Get parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_PROC_EXCHG       I SET_CDCY_SLCT_PARAMS          Controller cdcy_slct_m.do: Set parameters                   .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_PROC_EXCHG       I START_SELECTION               Indicator: Candidacy list was selected anew                 .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_SLCT_EXCHG       I GET_SUB_PARAMS                Parent Controller: Get parameters of subcontroller          .
IF_HRRCF_CDCY_SLCT_EXCHG       I RESET_DATA                    Parent Controller: Reset subcontroller data                 .
IF_HRRCF_CLASS_OVR_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CLASS_OVR_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_COMPANY_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_COMPANY_EXCHG         I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CONTAINERSEQUENCE     I CREATE_CONTROLLER             Generate or return requested subcontroller                  .
IF_HRRCF_CONTAINERSEQUENCE     I GET_ACTIVE_URLS               Returns active URLs for the application                     .
IF_HRRCF_CONTAINERSEQUENCE     I IS_STARTPAGE_RUNNING          Returns whether start page is running                       .
IF_HRRCF_CONTAINERSEQUENCE     I SET_CURRENT_ITEM              Set selected item                                           .
IF_HRRCF_CONTAINERSEQUENCE     I SET_GLOBAL_CONTEXT            Set global context                                          .
IF_HRRCF_CONTENT_EXTRACTOR     I GET_CONTENT                   Provides Content of Source for HROBJECT                     .
IF_HRRCF_DYNAMIC_CTRL_CALLS    I GET_PARAMS                    Read Controller and Comp_id                                 .
IF_HRRCF_DYNAMIC_CTRL_CALLS    I SET_PARAMS                    Set Controller and Comp_id                                  .
IF_HRRCF_EE_AWZD_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_EVENT                 I ON_CREATE                     onCreate Event                                              .
IF_HRRCF_EVENT                 I ON_INITIALIZATION             onInitialization Event                                      .
IF_HRRCF_EXT_DEC_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_EXT_DEC_EXCHG         I SET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_FASTTRACK             I GET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_FASTTRACK             I SET_PARAMS                    Parameter Set                                               .
IF_HRRCF_HEADER                I HIDE                          Hide Header                                                 .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_CRITERIAS                 Gets Table with Search Criteria                             .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_HITLIST                   Gets Table of HROBJECTs Found                               .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_HITS_PER_PAGE             Get Hits per Page of Hit List                               .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_IS_RANKING                Ranking enabled?                                            .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_IS_WEIGHT_MANDATORY       Are weighting/mandatory conditions allowed to be specified? .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I GET_WEIGHTS_MANDATORY         Returns internal table containing weights/mandatory assignmt.
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I RESET_SEARCH                  Resets Search to Initial Value                              .
IF_HRRCF_HITLIST_CTRL          I SET_SHOW_SEARCH               SearchTemplateGroupController Should Display Search         .
IF_HRRCF_HROBJECT_EXCHG        I GET_HROBJECT                  Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_HROBJECT_EXCHG        I SET_HROBJECT                  Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_HROBJECT_EXP          I GET_PARAMETER                 Returns the HROBJECT                                        .
IF_HRRCF_HROBJECT_SUBTY_EXCHG  I GET_HROBJECT_SUBTY            Exportiert Parameter                                        .
IF_HRRCF_HROBJECT_SUBTY_EXCHG  I SET_HROBJECT_SUBTY            Importiert Parameter                                        .
IF_HRRCF_JUMP_AND_BACK         I ON_BACK                       Back                                                        .
IF_HRRCF_JUMP_AND_BACK         I SET_CONTROLLER                Set Controller To Be Called                                 .
IF_HRRCF_JUMP_AND_BACK         I SET_GLOBAL_CONTEXT            Set Global Context Parameters                               .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL           I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL           I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL_HRIPKEY   I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL_HRIPKEY   I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL_HROBJECT  I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_DETAIL_HROBJECT  I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_PRO_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Get parameter from Parent Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_PRO_EXCHG        I REFRESH_LIST                  Parameter: update list                                      .
IF_HRRCF_LIST_PRO_EXCHG        I SET_PARAMS                    Set parameters of Parent Controller                         .
IF_HRRCF_MD_APPL_DATA_EXCHG    I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_APPL_DATA_EXCHG    I SET_PARAMS                    Import Parameter                                            .
IF_HRRCF_MD_CONFIRM_EXCHG      I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_CONFIRM_EXCHG      I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_DUPLI_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_DUPLI_EXCHG        I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXCHG              I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter - Ext                                     .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXCHG              I GET_PARAMS_INT                Exports Parameter - Int                                     .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXCHG              I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter - Ext                                     .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXCHG              I SET_PARAMS_INT                Imports Parameter - Int                                     .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXT_EXCHG          I GET_PARAMS                    Gets parameters from Main Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_MD_EXT_EXCHG          I SET_PARAMS                    Sets parameters in Main Controller                          .
IF_HRRCF_MD_INT_EXCHG          I GET_PARAMS                    Gets parameters from Main Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_MD_INT_EXCHG          I SET_PARAMS                    Sets parameters in Main Controller                          .
IF_HRRCF_MD_OVRV_DATA_EXCHG    I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_OVRV_DATA_EXCHG    I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_MD_SUBVIEW            I RESET_DATA                    Initialize Data                                             .
IF_HRRCF_MD_SUBVIEW            I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters in Main Controller - Ext                     .
IF_HRRCF_MPROC_COR_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Reads List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs              .
IF_HRRCF_MPROC_COR_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Sets List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs               .
IF_HRRCF_MPROC_COR_EXCHG       I START_SELECTION               Indicator: Select list of correspondence activities again   .
IF_HRRCF_MSG_EXCHG             I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_MVIEW_ACT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Reads List of HR Objects                                    .
IF_HRRCF_MVIEW_ACT_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Sets Level of Detail of Page                                .
IF_HRRCF_NAVIGATION_EXP        I GET_EVENT_ID                  Read Event ID                                               .
IF_HRRCF_NAVIGATION_EXP        I SET_EVENT_ID                  Set Event ID                                                .
IF_HRRCF_NAV_CTRL_CALL         I ON_FOCUS_LOST                 A Different Main Controller Should Be Displayed             .
IF_HRRCF_NV_CTRL_CALLS         I ON_CHECK_FOR_DATA             Checks for Data Existence on Display of Ticks               .
IF_HRRCF_NV_CTRL_CALLS         I ON_CONTAINER_NAVIGATION       Navigation Within Container Sequence Occurs                 .
IF_HRRCF_NV_CTRL_CALLS         I ON_FOCUS_LOST                 Focus for Display Controller Is Lost                        .
IF_HRRCF_NV_CTRL_STATIC        I GET_RPL_NODES                 Returns Replacement Nodes                                   .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_CP         Buffer Central Person                                       .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_NA         Buffer Candidate                                            .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_NB         Buffer Requisition                                          .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_NC         Buffer Posting                                              .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_ND         Buffer Application                                          .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_NE         Buffer Candidacy                                            .
IF_HRRCF_OBJECT_BUFFER         I FILL_OBJECT_BUFFER_NF         Buffer Talent Group                                         .
IF_HRRCF_OIX                   I GET_XML_TABLE                 Read XML Table via RFC                                      .
IF_HRRCF_PARAMETER_EXCHG       I GET_PARAM                     Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_PARAMETER_EXCHG       I SET_PARAM                     Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_PASSWORD_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Returns Parameters                                          .
IF_HRRCF_PERIODICAL_SERVICE    I RUN                           Starts a Periodic Operation                                 .
IF_HRRCF_PERS_PAGE_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS_PRIVACY            Sets Data Privacy Flag                                      .
IF_HRRCF_PERS_PAGE_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS_PROFILE            Sets Profile Status                                         .
IF_HRRCF_PINSTAPPL_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_PINST_MNT_EXCHG       I GET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Exports Parameters for List/Detail                          .
IF_HRRCF_PINST_MNT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_PINST_MNT_EXCHG       I GET_STATUS_PARAMS             Exports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_PINST_MNT_EXCHG       I SET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Imports Parameters for List/Detail                          .
IF_HRRCF_PINST_MNT_EXCHG       I SET_STATUS_PARAMS             Imports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_POST_INSTANCE_EXP     I GET_POST_INSTANCE             Gets HRIKEY or External Code of Posting Instance            .
IF_HRRCF_POST_INSTANCE_EXP     I SET_POST_INSTANCE             Sets HRIKEY or External Code of Posting Instance            .
IF_HRRCF_POST_LST_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_POST_MNT_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_POST_MNT_EXCHG        I GET_STATUS_PARAMS             Exports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_POST_MNT_EXCHG        I SET_STATUS_CHANGED            Set Status Change Pointer                                   .
IF_HRRCF_POST_MNT_EXCHG        I SET_STATUS_PARAMS             Imports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_PROFILE_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_ELEMENT_SUBVIEW    I GET_SELECTED_VALUES           Returns Responses of a Question                             .
IF_HRRCF_QA_ELEMENT_SUBVIEW    I IS_MANDATORY_FILLED           Check Whether Mandatory Question Was Answered               .
IF_HRRCF_QA_MODE_EXCHG         I GET_PARAM                     Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTBLD_DSGN_EXCHG  I GET_PARAMS                    Get Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTBLD_DSGN_EXCHG  I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTBLD_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Get Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTBLD_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTELIST_EXCHG     I SET_OWN_LIST                  Set Expanded List                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTLIST_EXCHG      I GET_PARAMS                    Get Question List                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_QSTLIST_EXCHG      I SET_PARAMS                    Set Question List                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_RANKG_EXCHG        I GET_LIST_PARAMS               Data Transfer Main Initial Page -" Ranking                  .
IF_HRRCF_QA_RANKG_EXCHG        I GET_SELECTION_PARAMS          Data Transfer Main Initial Page -" Selection Criteria       .
IF_HRRCF_QA_RANKG_EXCHG        I SET_LIST_PARAMS               Data Transfer Ranking -" Main Initial Page                  .
IF_HRRCF_QA_RANKG_EXCHG        I SET_SELECTION_PARAMS          Data Transfer Selection Criteria -" Main Initial Page       .
IF_HRRCF_QA_SCREEN_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QA_SCREEN_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Parameter Set                                               .
IF_HRRCF_QA_SCREEN_EXT_CTRL    I ON_EXT_CHANGE_MODE            External Event: change display mode                         .
IF_HRRCF_QA_SCREEN_EXT_CTRL    I ON_EXT_SAVE                   External Event: save                                        .
IF_HRRCF_QA_SCREEN_EXT_CTRL    I ON_EXT_SUBMIT                 External Event: send                                        .
IF_HRRCF_QUERY_EXCHG           I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_QUERY_EXCHG           I SET_CONTROLLER_ACTIVE         Activate Controllers                                        .
IF_HRRCF_QUERY_EXCHG           I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_RECPL_ACT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_RECPL_ACT_EXCHG       I HAS_ERROR                     Error?                                                      .
IF_HRRCF_RECPL_ACT_EXCHG       I REMOVE_PROCESS                Delete Process                                              .
IF_HRRCF_RECPL_ACT_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_REC_WLIST_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Reads List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs              .
IF_HRRCF_REC_WLIST_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Sets List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs               .
IF_HRRCF_REG_APPLN_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_REG_SRCH_EXCHG        I SET_CURRENT_PINST             Import Posting Instance                                     .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_DEL_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Reads List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs              .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_DEL_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Sets List of Candidacy IDs and Activity GUIDs               .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_MRD_EXCHG       I GET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Reads Selected Requisition (HROBJECT)                       .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_MRD_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Reads List of Requisitions (HROBJECT)                       .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_MRD_EXCHG       I REFRESH_LIST                  Parameter: update list                                      .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_MRD_EXCHG       I SET_LIST_DETAIL_PARAMS        Sets Selected Requisition (HROBJECT)                        .
IF_HRRCF_REQUI_MRD_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Sets List of Requisitions (HROBJECT)                        .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_LST_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_LST_EXCHG         I SET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_MNT_EXCHG         I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_MNT_EXCHG         I GET_STATUS_PARAMS             Exports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_MNT_EXCHG         I SET_STATUS_CHANGED            Sets Pointer: Status Changed                                .
IF_HRRCF_REQ_MNT_EXCHG         I SET_STATUS_PARAMS             Imports Parameters for Status Pages                         .
IF_HRRCF_RPACT_LST_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_CLIENT      I GET_PARAMS                    Get the Calling Parameters                                  .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_CLIENT      I ON_CANCEL                     Search help was terminated                                  .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_CLIENT      I ON_VALUES_SELECTED            Selection of Multiple Values                                .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_CLIENT      I ON_VALUE_SELECTED             Value was selected                                          .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Set Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_VARIANT     I GET_SMGROUPID                 Get the Search Mask Group ID                                .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_VARIANT     I GET_VARIANT                   Get the Calling Parameters                                  .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCHHLP_VARIANT     I SET_VARIANT                   Value was selected                                          .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I GET_HITLIST_ATTRIBUTES        Returns List of Hits                                        .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I GET_SEARCH_SETTINGS           Gets Settings for Search                                    .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I GET_SM_GROUP_ID               Return Current Group ID                                     .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I GET_VARIANT                   Return Current Variant                                      .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I SET_HITLIST_ATTRIBUTES        Sets Hit List                                               .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I SET_SHOW_HITLIST              Sets Flag for Display of Hit List                           .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I SET_SHOW_MORE_FIELDS          Set flag for showing more fields                            .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I SET_SHOW_VARIANT              Sets Flag for Display of Variants                           .
IF_HRRCF_SEARCH_EXP            I SET_VARIANT                   Sets Current Variant                                        .
IF_HRRCF_SF_PUBLICATION_EXP    I GET_PARAMS                    Gets Posting Object and Channel                             .
IF_HRRCF_SPB_TRIGGERS          I TRIGGER_SPB_FOR_ALL_HROBJECTS Starts Builder for All Relevant HROBJECTs                   .
IF_HRRCF_SPB_TRIGGERS          I TRIGGER_SPB_FOR_CP            Starts Builder for Current Change Pointer                   .
IF_HRRCF_SPB_TRIGGERS          I TRIGGER_SPB_FOR_HROBJECT      Starts Builder for a HROBJECT                               .
IF_HRRCF_SPROC_ACT_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SPROC_ACT_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_STANDALONEPAGE        I GET_ACTIVE_URLS               Returns active URLs for the application                     .
IF_HRRCF_STANDALONEPAGE        I IS_STARTPAGE_RUNNING          Returns whether start page is running                       .
IF_HRRCF_STANDALONEPAGE        I SET_NO_BUTTONGROUP            Set attribute no_btngrp                                     .
IF_HRRCF_STARTPAGE             I GET_PREVIOUS_CONTROLLER       Returns Previous Controller                                 .
IF_HRRCF_STARTPAGE             I ON_BACK                       Event Handler: Back                                         .
IF_HRRCF_STARTPAGE             I REGISTER_ACTIVE_URL           Registration of Active URL                                  .
IF_HRRCF_STARTPAGE             I SET_CONTROLLER                Set controller to be displayed                              .
IF_HRRCF_STAT_HIST_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SUBVIEW               I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Consistency Check                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SUBVIEW               I SAVE_TO_DATABASE              Save Data                                                   .
IF_HRRCF_SVIEW                 I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Consistency Check                                           .
IF_HRRCF_SVIEW                 I SAVE_TO_DATABASE              Save                                                        .
IF_HRRCF_TGCA_CREA_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_TGCA_CREA_EXCHG       I GET_RESULT_LIST               Export Result List                                          .
IF_HRRCF_TGCA_CREA_EXCHG       I SET_RESULT_LIST               Import Result List                                          .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_EXCHG       I GET_TG_LIST_PARAMS            Controller tg_list_m.do: Get Parameter                      .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_EXCHG       I GET_TG_SLCT_PARAMS            Controller tg_slct_m.do: Get Parameter                      .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_EXCHG       I SET_TG_SLCT_PARAMS            Controller tg_slct_m.do: Set Parameter                      .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_EXCHG       I START_SELECTION               List of Talent Group Assignments for New Selection          .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_LIST_EXCHG  I GET_PARAMS                    Get parameter from Parent Controller                        .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_LIST_EXCHG  I REFRESH_LIST                  Indicator: update list of candidacies                       .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_LIST_EXCHG  I SET_STARTSELECTION            Indicator: Refresh List                                     .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_SLCT_EXCHG  I GET_SUB_PARAMS                Parent Controller: Get parameters of subcontroller          .
IF_HRRCF_TG_ASGNMT_SLCT_EXCHG  I RESET_DATA                    Parent Controller: Reset subcontroller data                 .
IF_HRRCF_TG_EXCHG              I GET_PARAMS                    Export Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_TG_EXCHG              I SET_PARAMS                    SET parameter                                               .
IF_HRRCF_TPI_SHTL_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Import Parameters                                           .
IF_HRRCF_UNRG_APPL_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRRCF_USER_MNT_EXCHG        I GET_MSG_PARAMS                Get Parameters for the Confirmation Message                 .
IF_HRRCF_USER_MNT_EXCHG        I GET_PARAMS                    Get Parameters                                              .
IF_HRRCF_USER_MNT_EXCHG        I SET_MSG_PARAMS                Set Parameters for the Confirmation Message                 .
IF_HRSCP_CAND_SRCH_EXCHG       I GET_PARAMS                    Exports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRSCP_CAND_SRCH_EXCHG       I SET_PARAMS                    Imports Parameter                                           .
IF_HRSCP_CDCY_DESC_EXCHG       I GET_HEADER_HROBJECT           Get Object for Header                                       .
IF_HRSCP_REQ_MNT_ORGINT_EXCHG  I DATA_EXISTS                   Checks If Data Was Entered                                  .
IF_HRSEN_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ                          Read Several Records of an Infotype                         .
IF_HRSEN_READ_INFOTYPE         I READ_SINGLE                   Read Individual Infotype Record                             .
IF_HRSEN_READ_P0552_CONDITION  I IS_CONDITION_SATISFIED        Condition for Selection of Infotype 0552                    .
IF_HRSEN_READ_PERIOD_PEAK_TEXT I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_HRSEN_READ_PERIOD_PEAK_TEXT I READ_TEXT                     Read a text assign to a period or a peak                    .
IF_HRSEN_SUBTYPE_0552          I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_HRSEN_SUBTYPE_0552          I SPECIFIC_COMPUTATIONS         Subtype-dependent checks                                    .
IF_HRTM00_TL_CALCULATION       I CALCULATION                   Calculation of Status Traffic Lights                        .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I EXECUTE_ADVANCED_SEARCH       Execute Extended Object Search                              .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I EXECUTE_SIMPLE_SEARCH         Execute Simple Object Search                                .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I GET_FIELDS_FOR_ADVANCED_SEARCHRead Search Template Fields for Extended Search             .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I GET_FIELDS_FOR_SIMPLE_SEARCH  Read Search Template Fields for Simple Search               .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I GET_VALUEHELP_ADVANCED_SEARCH Read Input Help for Search Template Field for Ext. Search   .
IF_HRWPC_OADP_OBJECTSEARCH     I GET_VALUEHELP_SIMPLE_SEARCH   Read Input Help for Search Template Field for Simple Search .
IF_HRXSS_SER_RFW               I PROCESS_ACTION                process action which is sent by front-end                   .
IF_HR_ACTIONTOOL               I UNREGISTER_EVENTHANDLER       Deregisters Event Handler for Object Manager Events         .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I CHANGE                        Change a bond owner                                         .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I COPY                          Copy a bond owner                                           .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I CREATE                        Create a bond owner                                         .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I DELETE                        Delete a bond owner                                         .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I DELETE_ALL                    Delete all bond owners from a bond purchase                 .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I DISPLAY                       Display a bond owner                                        .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I GET_ALL                       Get all bond owners                                         .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I GET_COUNT                     Get the number of bond owners                               .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I LIST                          List all bond owners                                        .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I RESTORE                       Restore all changes of bond owners                          .
IF_HR_BOND_OWNER               I SAVE                          Save bond owners                                            .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I CHANGE                        Change a bond purchase                                      .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I COPY                          Copy a bond purchase                                        .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I CREATE                        Create a bond purchase                                      .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I DELETE                        Delete a bond purchase                                      .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I DISPLAY                       Display a bond purchase                                     .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I GET_ALL                       Get all bond purchases                                      .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I GET_COUNT                     Get the number of bond purchases                            .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I GET_OBJID                     Get bond purchase object ID                                 .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I LIST                          List all bond purchases                                     .
IF_HR_BOND_PURCHASE            I SAVE                          Save the bond purchase                                      .
IF_HR_FAMILY_RELATED           I DISPLAY                       Display one family/related member                           .
IF_HR_FAMILY_RELATED           I LIST                          List all family members and self                            .
IF_HR_LSTCE_ALV                I GET_OUTTAB                    GET_OUTTAB                                                  .
IF_HR_LSTCE_ALV                I SET_OUTTAB                    SET_OUTTAB                                                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I APPEND_IT                     Append line(s) to IT                                        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I APPEND_RT                     Append line(s) to RT                                        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I CLEAR                         Initialize the context                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_AB                        Get AB                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_ALL_PERNR                 Get list of all PERNRs in context                           .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_APER                      Get APER                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_AVERAGE                   Get average table                                           .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_C0                        Get C0                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_C1                        Get C1                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_CABC                      Get CABC                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_CRT                       Get CRT                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_DDNTK                     Get DDNTK                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_FUND                      Get FUND                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_IT                        Get IT                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_LRT                       Get internal table LRT                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_MODIF                     Get MODIF                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_RT                        Get RT                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_SWITCHES                  Get global switches from image                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_V0                        Get V0                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_VARIABLES                 Get global variables from image                             .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_WPBP                      Get RT                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I GET_ZL                        Get ZL                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I NEXT_BT_SPLIT                 Find next split for table BT (highest + 1)                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I NEXT_C1_SPLIT                 Find next split for table C1 (highest + 1)                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I NEXT_V0_SPLIT                 Find next split for table V0 (highest + 1)                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_ALL_ALLAP                 Put all ALLAPs                                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_ALL_APER                  Put all APERs                                               .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_ALL_NEW_RGDIR             Put all NEW_RGDIRs                                          .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_ALL_RGDIR                 Put all RGDIRs                                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_AVERAGE                   Put average table                                           .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_C0                        Put C0                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_C1                        Put C1                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_CRT                       Put CRT                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_FUND                      Put FUND                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_IT                        Put IT                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_MODIF                     Put MODIF                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_RT                        Put RT                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_V0                        Put V0                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_WPBP                      Put WPBP                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I PUT_ZL                        Put ZL                                                      .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I REFRESH_DT                    Refresh all DT tables                                       .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I RESTORE_IMAGE                 Restore image for PERNR                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I SAVE_IMAGE                    Save image for PERNR                                        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I SET_CE                        Set the CE flag for the context                             .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT              I SET_REFERENCE                 Set the reference inside the context                        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Get cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_OSMTH                     Old Superannuation - Monthly                                .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_OSQTR                     Old Superannuation - Quarterly                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_QHDA                      Higher Duty Allowance                                       .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_QSPR                      HR-AU-PS: Superannuation for Public Sector Australia        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_QSUP                      Superannuation                                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_RETP                      Retro Amts from Prev Financial Year                         .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_SHRS                      Superannuation - Hourly                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_SMTH                      Superannuation - Monthly                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_SQTR                      Superannuation - Quarterly                                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_SUPCOM                    HR-AU-PS: Superable salary components                       .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I GET_TAXP                      Taxation                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Put cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_OSMTH                     Old Superannuation - Monthly                                .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_OSQTR                     Old Superannuation - Quarterly                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_QHDA                      Higher Duty Allowance                                       .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_QSPR                      HR-AU-PS: Superannuation for Public Sector Australia        .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_QSUP                      Superannuation                                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_RETP                      Retro Amts from Prev Financial Year                         .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_SHRS                      Superannuation - Hourly                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_SMTH                      Superannuation - Monthly                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_SQTR                      Superannuation - Quarterly                                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_SUPCOM                    HR-AU-PS: Superable salary components                       .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I PUT_TAXP                      Taxation                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_AU           I SET_REFERENCE_AU              Set the references for AU tables and variables              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_BPIT                      Get BPIT                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Get cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TAX1                      Get TAX1                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TAX2                      Get TAX2                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TAXA                      Get TAXA                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TAXI                      Get TAXI                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TAXO_RT                   Get TAXO_RT                                                 .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TCRT                      Get TCRT                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_TCRTI                     Get TCRTI                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_WCB1                      Get WCB1                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I GET_XTBLGART                  Get XTBLGART                                                .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_BPIT                      Put BPIP                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Put cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_ROE                       Put ROE                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TAX1                      Put TAX1                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TAX2                      Put TAX2                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TAXA                      Put TAXA                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TAXI                      Put TAXI                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TAXO_RT                   Put TAXO_RT                                                 .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TCRT                      Put TCRT (called dynamically from ADDCU)                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_TCRTI                     Put TCRTI (called dynamically from ADDCU)                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_VC1                       Put VC1                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_VC2                       Put VC2                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_WCB1                      Put  WCB1                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I PUT_XTBLGART                  Put XTBLGART                                                .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_CA           I SET_REFERENCE_CA              Set the references for CA tables and variables              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Get cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_NRCT                      Get NRCT (needed for payroll log)                           .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_OFFSET_IN                 Get OFFSET_IN                                               .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_OFFSET_OUT                Get OFFSET_OUT (needed for payroll log)                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_OLD_RT                    Get OLD_RT                                                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_OLD_TAX                   Get OLD_TAX                                                 .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_PERM                      Get PERM                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_RETRO_TABLES              Get OLD_RT, OLD_BAL, OLD_UNB                                .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_TAX                       Get TAX                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_TAXPR                     Get TAXPR                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_TAXR                      Get TAXR                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_TCRT                      Get TCRT                                                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_UMODIF                    Get UMODIF                                                  .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_UTIPS                     Get UTIPS (needed for payroll log)                          .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I GET_XDFRT                     Get XDFRT                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_BAL                       Put BAL                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_CUMUL_TAB_ALL             Put cumul_tab_all (internal table used for SETCU/ADDCU)     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_NRCT                      Put NRCT (called dynamically from ADDCU)                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_OFFSET_OUT                Puf OFFSET_OUT                                              .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_TAX                       Put TAX                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_TCRT                      Put TCRT (called dynamically from ADDCU)                    .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_UNB                       Put UNB                                                     .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_UTIPS                     Put UTIPS (called dynamically from ADDCU)                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I PUT_XDFRT                     Put XDFRT                                                   .
IF_HR_PAY_CONTEXT_US           I SET_REFERENCE_US              Set the references for US tables and variables              .
IF_HR_PM_OBJECT                I CHECK_EXISTANCE               Checks if Object (Still) Exists                             .
IF_HR_PM_OBJECT                I GET_OBJECT_KEY                Specifies Business Key and Object Type                      .
IF_HR_PM_OBJECT                I GET_PROCEDURE_CREATE          Specifies Procedure to Create New Obj. for Consistency Check.
IF_HR_PM_OBJECT                I GET_PROCEDURE_STATUS          Specifies Procedures to Set Status for Consistency Check    .
IF_HR_PM_OBJECT                I GET_STATUS_TEXT               Provides Text That Belongs to a Specific Status             .
IF_HR_PM_ST_OBJECT_SUPPLIER    I CHECK_STATUS_OF_OBJECTS       Checks Status of Objects Before Selection                   .
IF_HR_PM_ST_OBJECT_SUPPLIER    I DETERMINE_OFFER_OF_STEP       Determines Objects That Step can Provide                    .
IF_HR_PM_ST_OBJECT_SUPPLIER    I DETERMINE_RESULT_OF_STEP      Determines Objects of a Step                                .
IF_HR_PM_ST_OBJECT_SUPPLIER    I INSERT_OBJECTS                Inserts New Objects                                         .
IF_HR_PROCESS_SUGGESTION       I ADD_VALUE                     Addition of Default Values                                  .
IF_HR_PROCESS_SUGGESTION       I GET_VALUE                     Determination of Default Value                              .
IF_HR_PROCESS_SUGGESTION       I IS_OBJECT_THERE               Existence Check for Object                                  .
IF_HR_PROCESS_SUGGESTION       I IS_VALUE_THERE                Existence Check for Default Value                           .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_ADD_INFO      I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns Direct Children of Main Object                      .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_ADD_INFO      I GET_PARENT                    Returns Parent of Main Object                               .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_FAVORITES     I DELETE_FAVORITE               Favorite will be deleted                                    .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_FAVORITES     I END_OF_OBJECTMANAGER          Exiting Object Manager                                      .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_FAVORITES     I SAVE_FAVORITE                 Search Variant Saved as Favorite                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I CHANGE_DATE                   Changing Period/Key Date                                    .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I CHANGE_NODE                   Change node type                                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I DESTROY                       Exit search tool                                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I EXECUTE_SEARCH                Perform search                                              .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I EXPORT_TO_MEMORY              Exports status to ABAP memory                               .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I GET_MAIN_OBJECTS              Returns the 'Main Objects'                                  .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I GET_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Get Current Search Criteria                                 .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I INIT                          Initializing the Search Tool                                .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I INIT_FROM_MEMORY              Initializing Using Data from the ABAP Memory                .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GB            I SET_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Receives Current Search Criteria                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I CHANGE_DATE                   Changing Period/Key Date                                    .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I CHANGE_NODE                   Change node type                                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I DESTROY                       Exit search tool                                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I DISPLAY_RESULTS               Creates Control for Displaying Search Results               .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I EXECUTE_SEARCH                Perform search                                              .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I EXPORT_TO_MEMORY              Exports status to ABAP memory                               .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_CELLS_CONTENT             Returns Contents of Cells Entered                           .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_COLUMNS_CONTENT           Returns Contents of Columns Entered                         .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_MAIN_OBJECTS              Returns the 'Main Objects'                                  .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_ROWS_CONTENT              Returns Content of Lines Entered                            .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Get Current Search Criteria                                 .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_SELECTED_CELLS            Returns Selected Cells                                      .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Returns Selected Columns                                    .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Returns Selected Lines                                      .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I INIT                          Initializing the Search Tool                                .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I INIT_FROM_MEMORY              Initializing Using Data from the ABAP Memory                .
IF_HR_SEARCHTOOL_GS            I SET_SEARCH_CRITERIA           Receives Current Search Criteria                            .
IF_HTMLB_DATA                  I EVENT_DISPATCH                For Events: Dynamic Call                                    .
IF_HTMLB_DATA                  I EVENT_INITIALIZE              For Events: Initialize                                      .
IF_HTMLB_DATA                  I EVENT_SET_PARAMETERS          For Events: Parameters 1..9                                 .
IF_HTMLB_DATA                  I RESTORE_FROM_REQUEST          Create Input                                                .
IF_HTMLB_ELEMENT_DELEGATED     I DO_AT_BEGINNING               Call at Beginning of a BSP Element                          .
IF_HTMLB_ELEMENT_DELEGATED     I DO_AT_END                     Call at End of a BSP Element Content                        .
IF_HTMLB_ELEMENT_DELEGATED     I INITIALIZE                    Constructor                                                 .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I BREADCRUMB_CLICK              "htmlb:breadcrumb" onClick                                  .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I BUTTON_CLICK                  "htmlb:button" onClick                                      .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I CHECKBOX_CLICK                "htmlb:checkbox" onClick                                    .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DATE_NAVIGATOR_DAY_CLICK      "htmlb:dateNavigator" onDayClick                            .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DATE_NAVIGATOR_MONTH_CLICK    "htmlb:dateNavigator" Month-onClick                         .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DATE_NAVIGATOR_NEXT_CLICK     "htmlb:dateNavigator" onNavigate                            .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DATE_NAVIGATOR_PREVIOUS_CLICK "htmlb:dateNavigator" onMonthClick                          .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DATE_NAVIGATOR_WEEK_CLICK     "htmlb:dateNavigator" onWeekClick                           .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I DROPDOWNLISTBOX_SELECT        "htmlb:dropdownListBox" onSelect                            .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I LINK_CLICK                    "htmlb:link" onClick                                        .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I RADIOBUTTON_CLICK             "htmlb:checkbox" onClick                                    .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABLEVIEW_CELL_CLICK          "htmlb:tableView" onCellClick                               .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABLEVIEW_FILTER              "htmlb:tableView" onFilter                                  .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABLEVIEW_HEADER_CLICK        "htmlb:tableView" onHeaderClick                             .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABLEVIEW_NAVIGATE            "htmlb:tableView" onNavigate                                .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABLEVIEW_ROW_SELECTION       "htmlb:tableView" onRowSelection                            .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TABSTRIP_SELECT               "htmlb:tabStrip" onSelect                                   .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TRAY_COLLAPSE_CLICK           "htmlb:tray" onClick                                        .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TRAY_EDIT_CLICK               "htmlb:tray" onClick                                        .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TRAY_EXPAND_CLICK             "htmlb:tray" onClick                                        .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TRAY_REMOVE_CLICK             "htmlb:tray" onClick                                        .
IF_HTMLB_EVENT                 I TREE_CLICK                    "htmlb:tree"Tree-onClick                                    .
IF_HTMLB_TABLEVIEW_ITERATOR    I GET_COLUMN_DEFINITIONS        Column Definitions                                          .
IF_HTMLB_TABLEVIEW_ITERATOR    I RENDER_CELL_START             New Column in Row                                           .
IF_HTMLB_TABLEVIEW_ITERATOR    I RENDER_ROW_START              New row                                                     .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I APPEND_FIELD_URL              Appends the Given Name/Value to the Query String of the URL .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I AUTHENTICATE                  Logon Data (Basic Authentication)                           .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I CLOSE                         Close of HTTP connection                                    .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I CREATE_ABS_URL                Creates an Absolute URL                                     .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I CREATE_REL_URL                Creates a Relative URL                                      .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I ESCAPE_HTML                   HTML encodes the given string, e.g. replaces '"' with '<'.
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I ESCAPE_URL                    URL encodes the given string, e.g. replaces space with %20  .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I GET_LAST_ERROR                Returns Return Code of Last Method Call                     .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I LISTEN                        Waiting for HTTP Response                                   .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I RECEIVE                       Receipt of HTTP Response                                    .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I REFRESH_COOKIE                Refresh Cookie Object                                       .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I REFRESH_REQUEST               Refresh  Request Object                                     .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I REFRESH_RESPONSE              Refresh response Object                                     .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I SEND                          Structure of HTTP Connection and Dispatch of Data           .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I SEND_SAP_LOGON_TICKET         Send SAP Logon Ticket                                       .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I SET_COMPRESSION               Activation/Deactivation of Compression                      .
IF_HTTP_CLIENT                 I UNESCAPE_URL                  URL Decodes the Given String                                .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I ADD_COOKIE_FIELD              Sets the sub-field's value in the given cookie              .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I ADD_MULTIPART                 Creates a new multipart segment in this entity              .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I APPEND_CDATA                  Appends character data to the HTTP body of this entity      .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I APPEND_CDATA2                 Appends character data to the HTTP body of this entity      .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I APPEND_DATA                   Appends binary data to the HTTP body of this entity         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_COOKIE                 Deletes the cookie from the list of cookies                 .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_COOKIE_SECURE          Deletes the cookie from the list of cookies                 .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_FORM_FIELD             Deletes the form field from the list of form fields         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_FORM_FIELD_SECURE      Deletes the form field from the list of form fields         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_HEADER_FIELD           Deletes the Header Field from the List of Header Fields     .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I DELETE_HEADER_FIELD_SECURE    Deletes the Header Field from the List of Header Fields     .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I FROM_XSTRING                  Instantiates this entity from an xstring                    .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_CDATA                     Delivers the HTTP body of this entity as character data     .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Body Type (Text/HTML, for example)                          .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_COOKIE                    Returns the requested cookie data                           .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_COOKIES                   Delivers a List of All Cookies                              .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_COOKIE_FIELD              Returns the value of the sub-field of the cookie            .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_DATA                      Returns the HTTP body of this entity as binary data         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_DATA_LENGTH               Supplies the length in bytes of the HTTP body               .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_FORM_FIELD                Returns the value of the requested form field               .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_FORM_FIELDS               Returns a list of all form fields                           .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_FORM_FIELDS_CS            Returns a list of all form fields (case-sensitive)          .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_FORM_FIELD_CS             Returns the value of the specified form field (case-sens.)  .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_HEADER_FIELD              Returns the value of the specified header field             .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_HEADER_FIELDS             Returns a list of all header fields                         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_LAST_ERROR                Returns the return code of the last method call             .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_MULTIPART                 Returns the specified multipart segment of this entity      .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_SERIALIZED_MESSAGE_LENGTH Message Length (Value Only Known After Serialization)       .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I GET_VERSION                   Protocol Version (HTTP1/0, HTTP1/1)                         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I NUM_MULTIPARTS                Returns the number of multi-part segments of this entity    .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_CDATA                     Sets the HTTP body of this entity to the given char. data   .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_COMPRESSION               Activation/Deactivation of Compression                      .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_CONTENT_TYPE              Set the Body Type (Text/HTML, for example)                  .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_COOKIE                    Sets the given cookie                                       .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_DATA                      Sets the HTTP body of this entity to the given binary data  .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_FORMFIELD_ENCODING        Set Format for get_formfield(s)                             .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_FORM_FIELD                Sets the value of the specified form field                  .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_FORM_FIELDS               Sets all form fields from the given list                    .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_HEADER_FIELD              Sets the value of the specified header field                .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SET_HEADER_FIELDS             Sets all header fields from the given list                  .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I SUPPRESS_CONTENT_TYPE         Does Not Force text/html as Default                         .
IF_HTTP_ENTITY                 I TO_XSTRING                    Serializes this HTTP entity into an xstring                 .
IF_HTTP_EXTENSION              I HANDLE_REQUEST                Called for request handling for each incoming HTTP request  .
IF_HTTP_PROXY_CONFIG           I GET_PROXY_INFO                Determines Proxy Settings for HTTP Request                  .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I COPY                          Copy a Request Object                                       .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_AUTHORIZATION             Gets Information from the Authorization Header Fields       .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_FORM_DATA                 Gets Form Data and Puts It Into a Complex Data Structure    .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_METHOD                    Request Method (GET, POST, etc.)                            .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_RAW_MESSAGE               Returns the Entire HTTP Message                             .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_URI_PARAMETER             Gets the Value of the Requested URI Parameter               .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I GET_USER_AGENT                Gets User Agent Informationen from the Request              .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I SET_AUTHORIZATION             Sets the Authorization Header Field of this Request         .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I SET_METHOD                    Set the Method (GET, POST, etc.)                            .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I SET_VERSION                   Set the Protocol Version (HTTP/1.0, HTTP/1.1)               .
IF_HTTP_REQUEST                I SUPPRESS_CONTENT_TYPE         Does not force text/ HTML as default                        .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I COPY                          Copy a Response Object                                      .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I DELETE_COOKIE_AT_CLIENT       Deletes the specified cookie at the client side             .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I GET_RAW_MESSAGE               Returns the Entire HTTP Message                             .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I GET_STATUS                    Gets the current HTTP status code                           .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I REDIRECT                      Redirects the client to the specified URL                   .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I SERVER_CACHE_BROWSER_DEPENDENTSets browser-dependent HTML in response in the server cache .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I SERVER_CACHE_EXPIRE_ABS       Sets absolute expiry time for this response in server cache .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I SERVER_CACHE_EXPIRE_DEFAULT   Sets the expiry time for this response in server cache      .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I SERVER_CACHE_EXPIRE_REL       Sets relative expiry time for this response in server cache .
IF_HTTP_RESPONSE               I SET_STATUS                    Sets current HTTP status code                               .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I APPEND_FIELD_URL              Appends the Given Name/Value to the Query String of the URL .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I CREATE_ABS_URL                Creates an Absolute URL                                     .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I CREATE_REL_URL                Creates a Relative URL                                      .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I DECODE_BASE64                 Decodes a BASE64-Encoded String                             .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I ENCODE_BASE64                 BASE64 Encodes the Given String                             .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I ESCAPE_HTML                   HTML encodes the given string, e.g. replaces '"' with '<'.
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I ESCAPE_URL                    URL encodes the given string, e.g. replaces space with %20  .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I GET_EXTENSION_INFO            Gets Protocol, Host, Port, and URL for Request Handler      .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I GET_EXTENSION_URL             Gets Protocol, Host, Port, and URL for Request Handler      .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I GET_LAST_ERROR                Returns Return Code of Last Method Call                     .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I GET_LOCATION                  Gets Host, Port for Web AS in Customer Domain               .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I GET_LOCATION_EXCEPTION        Gets Host, Port from Exception Table Only                   .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I SEND_PAGE                     Sending Last Page                                           .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I SET_COMPRESSION               Activation/Deactivation of Compression                      .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I SET_SESSION_STATEFUL          Activation/deactivation of stateful session                 .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I SET_SESSION_STATEFUL_VIA_URL  Activating/Deactivating Stateful Session via URL Rewrite    .
IF_HTTP_SERVER                 I UNESCAPE_URL                  URL Decodes the Given String                                .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I CHECK_HTTP_WHITELIST          URL Comparison with a White List                            .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I DECODE_BASE64                 Decodes a BASE64-Encoded String                             .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I DECODE_UTF8                   Converts a string from UTF-8 to internal format             .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ENCODE_BASE64                 Encodes a String in BASE64                                  .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ENCODE_UTF8                   Converts a string from internal format to UTF-8             .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_HTML                   Executes HTML Escaping on a String                          .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_JAVASCRIPT             Executes Javascript Escaping on a String                    .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_URL                    Executes URL Escaping on a String                           .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_WML                    Executes URL Escaping on a String                           .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_XML_ATTR_VALUE         Executes XML Escaping for Attribut Values                   .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I ESCAPE_XML_CHAR_DATA          Executes XML Escaping for Data Between Two Nodes            .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I FIELDS_TO_STRING              Encodes a List of Fields as a Query String                  .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I GET_LAST_ERROR                Gets the Last Occurring Error Code                          .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I GET_LOGON_CHARSET             Returns the Suitable ISO Codepage for the Logon/Sys. Lang.  .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I IS_ICT_SYSTEM_CALL_IMPLEMENTEDIs system call available for entity processing (internal)   .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I IS_VALID_URL                  Checks whether a transferred string is a valid URL          .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I NORMALIZE_URL                 Normalized URL Path                                         .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I REWRITE_URL                   Formats a URL with URI Parameters                           .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I SET_QUERY                     Set Query String                                            .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I SET_REQUEST_URI               Sets the Request URI (Due to Upwards Compatibility)         .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I STRING_TO_FIELDS              Decodes a Query String into a List of Fields                .
IF_HTTP_UTILITY                I UNESCAPE_URL                  Executes URL Unescaping on a String                         .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_PROPVAL         I RENDER_TO_STRING              Property Value as String                                    .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_PROPVAL         I RENDER_TO_XML                 Property Value as XML Element                               .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I COPY                          Copy of Resource (COPY Request)                             .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I CUSTOM_REQUEST                Unknown Action (...-Request)                                .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I DELETE                        Deletion of Resource (DELETE-Request)                       .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET                           Documents of Resource (GET Request)                         .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_ACTIVELOCK                Current Lock                                                .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_CHILDREN                  Children                                                    .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_CONTENTLENGTH             Contents Size in Bytes                                      .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_CONTENTTYPE               Mime Type of Content                                        .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_CREATIONDATE              Creation Date                                               .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_DISPLAYNAME               Display name                                                .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_LASTMODIFIED              Changed On                                                  .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I GET_LOCKENTRY                 Possibility of Lock                                         .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I HEAD                          GET Without Body (HEAD-Request)                             .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I LOCK                          Lock of Resource (LOCK-Request)                             .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I MKCOL                         Creates a Folder under URL (MKCOL Request)                  .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I MOVE                          Move of Resource (MOVE-Request)                             .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I OPTIONS                       Possible Actions (OPTIONS-Request)                          .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I POST                          (POST Request)                                              .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I PROPFIND                      Read Properties of Resourse (PROFIND Request)               .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I PROPPATCH                     Set Properties of Resource (PROPPATCH-Request)              .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I PUT                           Creates a New Document under URL (PUT Request)              .
IF_HTTP_WEBDAV_RESOURCE        I UNLOCK                        Reset a Lock (UNLOCK-Request)                               .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Whether Particular Object Exists                      .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I CHECK_EXISTENCE_4X            Check Existance in Old Format                               .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I CHECK_EXTERNAL_NAME           Check External Name and Existance of Prerequisites          .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I CONVERT_FROM_4X               Conversion of Old Storage (3.1, 4.0 to 6.20)                .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I DELETE                        Delete Object                                               .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I DELETE_VERSION                Delete Object                                               .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I DETERMINE_LONG_NAME           Determine the Long Name of Mimes and Templates              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I EXT_TO_INT_NAME               External Name to Internal Name                              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I EXT_TO_INT_NAME_4X            External Name to Internal Name from Old Tables              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I GET_CONTENT                   Get Object Content from Database                            .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I GET_CONTENT_LANGUAGES         For Resources, Language-Dep. Templates and Lang-Dep. Mimes  .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I GET_TEXT                      Get Service Description                                     .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I MESSAGE_EXCLUDE_FROM_ACTION   Message to User that Object is Excluded from Action         .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I NAME_FROM_TRANSPORT_NAME      Transport Name is Given, Determine Object Name              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I OBJECTS_TO_CONVERT_FROM_4X    List of Objects for Conversion                              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I PUBLISH                       Publish Object                                              .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I PUBLISH_ALL                   Publish Object and Parts                                    .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I SPAU_ADJUSTMENT_EXISTS        Comparison Exists?                                          .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I TRANSPORT_NAME                Object Names for Transport Tools                            .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I WRITE_CONTENT                 Write Content to Database                                   .
IF_IAC_OBJECT                  I WRITE_HEADER                  Write Header Data                                           .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_CREATE                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_DELETE                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_GET_GROUP                 ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_GET_HANDLE                ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_READ                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ADDRESS_EVT           I HND_UPDATE                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I CL_SET_LOG_NAME               ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I DELETE_ARCHIVE_OBJ            DELETE_ARCHIVE_OBJ                                          .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I GET_DATA                      GET_DATA                                                    .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I GET_TABLE                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I PUT_RECORD                    PUT_RECORD                                                  .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE               I PUT_TABLE                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ARCHIVE_DEREGISTER    I DEREGISTER_ARCHIVE_OBJECT     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_AVL_NODE              I COMPARE                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_AVL_NODE              I PRINT                         ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I CHANGE_IBASE_MULTI            ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I CHANGE_IBASE_SINGLE           ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I CHECK_IBASE_MULTI             ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I CHECK_IBASE_SINGLE            ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I CREATE_IBASE                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I DELETE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I GET_IBASE_TEXTLINE            ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I GET_INFO                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_ENGINE_STATUS         I SWITCH_OBJNR                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_EQUIPMENT             I GET_EQUNO                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_EQUIPMENT             I IS_FULL                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_EXP                   I GET_OBJECTTYP                 Object Type                                                 .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I GET_ICON                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I GET_OBJ_FUNCTIONS             ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I GET_TREE_DATA                 ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I OBJECT_SPEC_FUNCTION          ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I READ                          ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_IBOF_TREE_OBJECT      I REFRESH                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_INSTALL               I CHILD_ALLOWED                 ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_INSTALL               I PARENT_ALLOWED                ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_MATERIAL              I GET_MATNO                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I CL_APPL_ID_CONSTRUCTOR        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I CL_IBASE_ID_CONSTRUCTOR       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I DOES_EXIST                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I GET_APPL_ID                   ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I GET_IBASE_ID                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I GET_UNIT                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I IS_SINGLE                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I READ                          ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_OBJECT                I REFRESH                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_R3_BOM                I GET_STANDARD_TEXT             Description                                                 .
IF_IBASE_R3_PM_MASTER_DATA     I CLEAR_ITOB                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_R3_PM_MASTER_DATA     I GET_ITOB_KEY                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_R3_PM_MASTER_DATA     I SET_ITOB                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_REQ_IBIN              I SET_IBIN                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_SERIALNO              I GET_MATNO                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_SERIALNO              I GET_SERNO                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I CHANGE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I CLONE                         ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I CL_REFRESH                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I COLLECT_ROOTS                 ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I COPY                          ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I CREATE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I CUT                           ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I DELETE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I DELETE_IBASE                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I EXIST_SUC                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I GET_PASTE_ROOTS               ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I NEW_IBASE                     ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I PASTE                         ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I READ_IBASE                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC                 I READ_LEVEL                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I CHANGE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I CONSOLIDATE                   ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I CREATE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I DELETE                        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I EXIST_RANGE                   ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I READ_RANGE                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_BUF             I SET_SEL                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_CHECK_STHG_TO_POST        ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_FREE                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_GET_CHANGE_FLAG           ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_GET_NAME                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_PREPARE_SAVE              ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_SAVE                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_EVT             I HND_SET_POST_DATA             ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_FILT            I ADD_ITEM                      ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_FILT            I REFRESH                       ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_STREAM          I CLEAR                         ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_STREAM          I GET_FIRST_ITEM                ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_STREAM          I GET_NEXT_ITEM                 ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_STRUC_STREAM          I WRITE_ITEM                    ...                                                         .
IF_IBASE_TEMP_ID               I GET_IBASE_ID                  ...                                                         .
IF_IBND_RULE_ENTRY_BCS         I ADDR_CHANGED                  Checks Whether Address Has Changed                          .
IF_IBRT_DB_CONVERT_SPECIAL     I RECNSTRCT_CLSSTYP_PROFILE_CNT Instance Data                                               .
IF_IBRT_DB_CONVERT_SPECIAL     I TRUNCATE_OBJECT_KEY_OF_STREF  Part-of Data                                                .
IF_IBRT_DB_READ_FIRST          I LOAD_CFG_SPECIAL              Read Configuration                                          .
IF_IBRT_DB_READ_SPECIAL        I LOAD_CFG_SPECIAL              Read Configuration                                          .
IF_ICF_AUTHENTICATION          I PROCESS_LOGON                 Log On                                                      .
IF_ICF_NOTIFY                  I NOTIFY                        Method for Triggering Notification                          .
IF_ICF_SERVICE_EXTENSION       I CONFIGURATION                 Configuration Entry for ICF Service                         .
IF_ICF_SYSTEM_LOGIN            I HTM_CHANGE_PASSWD             Layout for Changing Password                                .
IF_ICF_SYSTEM_LOGIN            I HTM_LOGIN                     Layout for Logging On                                       .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I CHANGE_EXT_ALIAS              Change External Alias in ICF Tree                           .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I CHANGE_INT_ALIAS              Change Internal Alias in ICF Tree                           .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Service in ICF Tree                                  .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I CHECK_SERVICE_ACTIVE          Check Whether Service Active                                .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I DELETE_EXT_ALIAS              Delete External Alias                                       .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Service in ICF Tree                                  .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I EXTALIAS_FROM_URL             Determines Existence of External ALIAS from URL             .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I FILTER_TO_SICF                Goto SICF Filter for Service                                .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I FILTER_TO_SICF_EXTALIAS       Goto SICF Filter for External Alias                         .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I GET_HEREDITY_VALUE            Gets Inherited Information for Service                      .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I GET_INFO_FROM_SERV            Gets Information for ICF Service                            .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I ICF_AUTHORITY_CHECK           Authority Check for ICF Framework                           .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I INSERT_EXT_ALIAS              Insert External Alias in ICF Tree                           .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I INSERT_INT_ALIAS              Insert Internal Alias in ICF Tree                           .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I INSERT_NODE                   Insert Service in ICF Tree                                  .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I INSERT_VIRT_HOST              Insert Service in ICF Tree                                  .
IF_ICF_TREE                    I SERVICE_FROM_URL              Gets Last Service in ICF Tree from URL                      .
IF_ICI_PHONE_LINE              I _DROP_CALLS                   ends all phone calls to one extension                       .
IF_ICI_PHONE_LINE              I _GET_CALLS                    gets all existing phone calls for one extension             .
IF_ICI_USER                    I _GET_ATTRIBUTES               read user parameter and autom. CC- logon                    .
IF_ICI_USER                    I _SUBSCRIBE                    subscription                                                .
IF_ICI_USER                    I _UNSUBSCRIBE                  unsubscription                                              .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_ADDRESSES                 get addresses of agent                                      .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_CHANNELS                  get all channels                                            .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_CURRENT_CHANNELS          get currently assigned channels                             .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_CURRENT_QUEUES            get currently assigned queues                               .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_CURRENT_WORKMODE          get current work mode                                       .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_QUEUES                    get all queues                                              .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_USERID                    get user ID                                                 .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_WORKMODES                 get all work modes A                                        .
IF_ICI_USER_GETTERS            I GET_WRAPUPMODE                get wrap up mode                                            .
IF_ICI_USER_SETTERS            I _SET_ADDRESSES                set user addresses                                          .
IF_ICI_USER_SETTERS            I _SET_CURRENT_CHANNELS         set user channels                                           .
IF_ICI_USER_SETTERS            I _SET_CURRENT_QUEUES           set user queues                                             .
IF_ICI_USER_SETTERS            I _SET_CURRENT_WORKMODE         set user workmode                                           .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_EXT            I GET_CURRENT                   Transfers mt_activity_cur to Caller                         .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_EXT            I GET_OLD                       Transfers mt_activity_old to Caller                         .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_EXT            I GET_SUBCLAIM_LOADED           Transfers the Subclaims for Which Tasks Were Loaded         .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_EXT            I GET_TASKS_FOR_PARENT_OBJECT   Determines Tasks That Belong to Specified Parent Object     .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_INT            I DELETE_LINE                   Removes a Task from mt_activity_cur                         .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_INT            I INSERT_LINE                   Adds a Task to mt_activity_cur                              .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_INT            I INSERT_LINES                  Adds a Table of Tasks to mt_activity_cur                    .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_INT            I REBUILD                       Sets Up Secondary Table Again                               .
IF_ICL_ACTIVITY_INT            I REFRESH_CURRENT               Deletion of Work Tables                                     .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_ADMISSION_DATA            Admission Data                                              .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_BP                        Procurement of Person-Related Data for Grouping             .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_CURRENT_ITEM_GROUPING     Current Claim Item Grouping                                 .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_DIAGNOSIS                 Procurement of Diagnoses for DRG Determination              .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_DISCHARGE_DATA            Discharge Data                                              .
IF_ICL_DRG_DATA_COLLECTION_UI  I GET_PROCEDURES                Procurement of Procedures for DRG Determination             .
IF_ICL_FAILER_LOG_UI           I APPEND_FAILER                 Add Error                                                   .
IF_ICL_ITEM_EXT                I GET_NEXT_SUBSEQNUM            Provide Next Subitem Number                                 .
IF_ICL_ITEM_EXT                I PROC_SEQNUM_FILL              Fill in sequences numbers for a pair of procurements        .
IF_ICL_PROCEDURES_AL           I REFRESH                       Deletion of Buffer                                          .
IF_ICL_PROCEDURES_AL           I SELECT_PROCEDURES             Selection of Procedures                                     .
IF_ICL_PROCEDURES_AL           I UPDATE_DB                     Saving of Changes (Insert, Update, Delete)                  .
IF_ICL_SEARCH_EVENT            I ATTRIBUTES_GET                Customizing for Search Integration                          .
IF_ICL_SEARCH_EVENT            I SEARCH_GET                    Determine Search                                            .
IF_IC_AC_IREC_ACCESS           I GET_ROOT_BORIDENTIFYER        Get BOR key, type and logical system                        .
IF_IC_AC_IREC_ACCESS           I IS_OBJECT_IREC                Returns true if object is interaction record                .
IF_IC_HR_PERSON                I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I GET_CB_REGISTRY_END_REQUEST   Get callback registry to process interaction end request    .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I GET_CURRENT_INTERACTION       Return current interaction                                  .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I GET_OVERLAP_INTERACTION       Return overlap interaction                                  .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I HAS_CURRENT_INTERACTION       Returns true if interaction is active                       .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I HAS_OVERLAP_INTERACTION       Returns true if overlapping interaction exists              .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I IS_IN_END_INTERACTION         Returns true if the end processing is going on              .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I SAVE_AND_COLLECT_CAD          Collect call-attached-data for transfer                     .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I SAVE_INTERACTION_AND_BO_LINKS Process interaction end request                             .
IF_IC_INTERACTION_MANAGER      I SET_VIEW_MANAGER              Set view manager, must be called after first get_instance   .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I ADD_ATTRIBUTE                 Add static, public read-only attribute                      .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I ADD_METHOD                    Add method                                                  .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I ADD_PARAMETER                 Add parameter                                               .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I ADD_REDEFINITION              Add redefinition                                            .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I ADD_SOURCE_TO_METHOD          Add method implementation                                   .
IF_IC_LTX_CLASS_DESCRIPTOR     I CLEAR_DESCRIPTOR_ATTRIBUTE    Clears specified attribute                                  .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I ADD_DDIC_DEFINITION           Add DDIC definition                                         .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I ADD_PARAMETER_DDIC_DEFINITION Add DDIC definition for paramter                            .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I ADD_PARAMETER_DEFINITION      Add parameter definition                                    .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I ADD_PARAMETER_DEFINITIONS     Add parameter definitions                                   .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I GET_DDIC_DEFINITION           Get DDIC definition for parameter                           .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I GET_VERSION                   Get version                                                 .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I HAS_RETURN_DF_BEEN_REQUESTED  Returns true if at least one parameter should be returned   .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I SAVE_DEFINITION               Save definition to database                                 .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I SET_EXTENDED_LIFE             Set extended life flag                                      .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I SET_RAISE_VETO                Set raise veto flag                                         .
IF_IC_LTX_DEFINITION           I SET_VERSION                   Set version                                                 .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I CHECK_HANDLER                 Check that  all handler attributes are accessible           .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I GET_GENERATOR_INSTANCE        Get transaction specific generator reference                .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I GET_HANDLER_DEFINITION        Get name/value table with handler definition                .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I GET_HANDLER_INSTANCE          Get handler instance                                        .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I GET_PAGENAME                  Get page name                                               .
IF_IC_LTX_HANDLER_FACTORY      I IS_ITS_BASED                  Returns true if transaction is ITS based                    .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETERS         Get all export parameters                                   .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETER_DETAILS  Get details for a specific export parameter                 .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I GET_EXPORT_PARAMETER_NAMES    Returns names of all export parameters                      .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I GET_IMPORT_PARAMETERS         Get all action import parameters                            .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I GET_IMPORT_PARAMETER_DETAILS  Get details for a specific action import parameter          .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I HAS_DATA_FLOW_BEEN_CHANGED    Returns true if data flow has been changed                  .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I SET_EXPORT_PARAMETER_VALUES   Set a specific export parameter                             .
IF_IC_LTX_PARAMETER_ACCESS     I SET_IMPORT_PARAMETER_VALUES   Set a specific action import parameter                      .
IF_IC_PROFILE                  I GET_COMPONENT_PROFILE         Get profile for specific component                          .
IF_IC_PROFILE                  I GET_PROFILE                   Get IC WebClient profile                                    .
IF_IC_PROFILE                  I GET_USER_DEFINED_PROFILE      Get IC WebClient profile defined in user parameter          .
IF_IC_PROFILE                  I SET_PROFILE                   Set IC WebClient Profile                                    .
IF_IC_XML_VALIDATION           I GET_XML_TO_BE_CHECKED         Determines the XML Files To Be Checked                      .
IF_IC_XML_VALIDATION           I SET_ALL_XML_TO_BE_CHECKED     Declare All XML Files To Be Validated                       .
IF_IC_XML_VALIDATION           I SET_XML_TO_BE_CHECKED         Declare All XML To Be Validated                             .
IF_IDX_IDOC_RESOURCE           I GET_IDOC                      Fetch IDoc                                                  .
IF_IDX_IDOC_RESOURCE           I SET_IDOC                      Set IDoc                                                    .
IF_IDX_IDOC_RESOURCE           I SET_XML2ITAB_CONV_DATA        XML-" IDoc Control Data                                     .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I ASYNC_SUPPORTED               Asynchronous Call Supported                                 .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I GET_IMPLEMENTATION_NAME       Determines the Implementing Function Module (See Docu)      .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I GET_PARAMETER                 Determines Reference to Data of a Parameter                 .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I GET_PARAMETER_NAMES           Lists the Parameters                                        .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I GET_RELEASE_STATUS            Determines the Release Status                               .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I GUI_REQUIRED                  Method Can Only Run with Dialog                             .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I IS_FACTORY                    Method Creates an Instance                                  .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I IS_OBSOLETE                   Determines if and Since When Method Is Obsolete             .
IF_IFR_BAPI                    I IS_STATIC                     Method Is Static or Instance Method                         .
IF_IFR_BOR                     I GET_BUSINESS_OBJECT           Returns Reference to a Business Object Description          .
IF_IFR_BOR                     I GET_BUSINESS_OBJECT_TYPES     Returns List with Names of the Business Objects             .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_BAPI                      Access to a Method                                          .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_BAPI_NAMES                Access to a List With BAPI Names                            .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_CREATION_RELEASE          Get Creation Release                                        .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_DEVCLASS                  Returns Package                                             .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_KEYFIELD                  Access to a Key Field                                       .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_KEYFIELD_NAMES            Access to a List of Key Field Names                         .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_LIST                      Determines List of Business Objects                         .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_NAME                      Name of Business Object                                     .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_OBJTYPE                   Technical Type Name                                         .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I GET_RELEASE_STATUS            Determines the Release Status                               .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I HAS_OUTBOUND_INTERFACES       Checks Whether the Object Has Outbound Interfaces           .
IF_IFR_BUSINESS_OBJECT         I IS_OBSOLETE                   Determines if and Since When Business Object Is Obsolete    .
IF_IFR_DDIC_REFERENCE          I GET_DDIC_FIELDNAME            Name of Dict. Field If Defined as a Structure/Field         .
IF_IFR_DDIC_REFERENCE          I GET_DDIC_REFERENCE            Complete Type Reference - i.e. Type or Structure AND Field  .
IF_IFR_DDIC_REFERENCE          I GET_DDIC_STRUCTURE            Name of Dictionary Structure, if Defined as Structure/Field .
IF_IFR_DDIC_REFERENCE          I GET_DDIC_TYPENAME             Name of Type if Defined Using Type Reference                .
IF_IFR_DDIC_REFERENCE          I GET_DEFINITION_KIND           Determines if Definition Is by Type or Structure AND Field  .
IF_IFR_DOCUMENTABLE_OBJECT     I GET_DOCU_KEYS                 Returns the Existing Documentation Keys                     .
IF_IFR_PARAMETER               I GET_DIRECTION                 Type of Parameter: Import, Export, Import/Export            .
IF_IFR_PARAMETER               I GET_INTERNAL_NAME             Internal Technical Name of Parameter                        .
IF_IFR_PARAMETER               I GET_NAME                      Name of Parameter in External Representation                .
IF_IFR_PARAMETER               I IS_MULTI_LINED                Consists of Multiple Lines of Type Specified?               .
IF_IFR_PARAMETER               I IS_OPTIONAL                   Parameter Declared Optionally                               .
IF_IFR_SHORTTEXTS              I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Determines the Short Text                                   .
IF_IFR_VERB                    I GET_CREATION_RELEASE          Gets Creation Release of Component                          .
IF_IFR_VERB                    I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Gets Name To Be Used for Display                            .
IF_IFR_VERB                    I GET_INTERNAL_NAME             Gets Internal, Technical Name                               .
IF_IGN_SEARCH                  I GET_DEFAULT_CRITERIA          Get Default Value for Search Criteria                       .
IF_IGN_SEARCH                  I START                         Start Search                                                .
IF_IGN_SEARCH_ALV_MANAGER      I DISPLAY                       Display Table in ALV Grid                                   .
IF_IGN_SEARCH_ALV_MANAGER      I FREE_ALV_GRID                 Release ALV Grid                                            .
IF_IGN_SEARCH_ALV_MANAGER      I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Determine Selected Table Lines                              .
IF_IGN_SEARCH_ALV_MANAGER      I HANDLE_FCODE                  Function Code Processing for Pushbuttons in PAI             .
IF_IGN_SEARCH_ALV_MANAGER      I SET_CONTAINER                 Set Container in Which ALV Grid Is Displayed                .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I CALL                          Execution of Transaction for Mode Object                    .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I CLOSE                         Closing Connection to Mode                                  .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I EXISTS                        Does Mode Exist                                             .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I GET_LAST_ERROR                Last Error Message                                          .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I SEND                          Send Data/Events to Mode Object                             .
IF_IMC_CHILD_MODE              I SET_PROPERTY                  Processing of SAPgui characteristics                        .
IF_IMC_MODEX                   I CALL                          Execution of Transaction for Mode Object                    .
IF_IMC_MODEX                   I CLOSE                         Closing Connection to Mode                                  .
IF_IMC_MODEX                   I GET_LAST_ERROR                Last Error Message                                          .
IF_IMC_MODEX                   I SEND                          Send Data/Events to Mode Object                             .
IF_IMC_MODEX                   I SET_VISIBLE_PROPERTY          Set GUI Property: Invisible                                 .
IF_IMC_PARENT_MODE             I CLOSE                         Closing Connection to Mode                                  .
IF_IMC_PARENT_MODE             I EXISTS                        Does Mode Exist                                             .
IF_IMC_PARENT_MODE             I GET_LAST_ERROR                Last Error Message                                          .
IF_IMC_PARENT_MODE             I SEND                          Send Data/Events to Mode Object                             .
IF_IMC_PARENT_MODE             I SET_PROPERTY                  Processing of SAPgui characteristics                        .
IF_INBOUND_EXIT_BCS            I CREATE_INSTANCE               Creates an Object Instance with This Interface              .
IF_INBOUND_EXIT_BCS            I PROCESS_INBOUND               Call Exit Logic                                             .
IF_INVOICE_BW                  I CHANGE_IN_UPDATE              Enrichment of Communication Structure                       .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT            External Identifier -" Intenal Identifier                   .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I CONVERT_INT_TO_EXT            Internal Identifiers -" External Identifiers                .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I DISPLAY_F1                    Display F1 Help                                             .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I DISPLAY_F4                    F4 help                                                     .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I DISPLAY_IDENTIFIER            Display identifier                                          .
IF_INV_IDENTIFIER              I DISPLAY_TEXT                  Read Data Element Text                                      .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_F1                    F1 Help                                                     .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_RECEIVER              Display Receiver                                            .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_RECEIVER_F4           Display Bill Recipient Using F4 Help                        .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_RECEIVER_TEXT         Read Texts for Bill Recipient (Data Element)                .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_SENDER                Display Senders                                             .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_SENDER_F4             Display Bill Sender Using F4 Help                           .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I DISPLAY_SENDER_TEXT           Read Texts for Bill Sender (Data Element)                   .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I GET_RECEIVER                  Read Recipient                                              .
IF_INV_SENDER_RECEIVER         I GET_SENDER                    Read Sender                                                 .
IF_IOS_COMMUNICATIONWRAPPER    I CALL_METHOD                   Generic Dispatcher                                          .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I CALL_METHOD                   Generic Dispatcher                                          .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I CREATE_PROXYCONTROLER         gets proxy controller object                                .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I GET_PROXYOBJECT               gets special proxy object of controller                     .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I GET_USEDCOMMUNICATION         X:ActiveX, else Java                                        .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I SET_PROPERTY                  generic dispatcher                                          .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I SET_PROPERTY_DATAPROVIDER     Generic dispatcher, only valid no wd                        .
IF_IOS_DELEGATOR               I SET_USEDCOMMUNICATION         X:ActiveX, else Java                                        .
IF_IOS_FACTORY                 I SET_CONTAINER                 only non webdynpro frontends, container inplace view        .
IF_IOS_FACTORY                 I SET_DOCTYPE                   Sets Documenttyp                                            .
IF_IOS_FACTORY                 I SET_DOCUMENT                  dataprovider compatible url                                 .
IF_IOS_FACTORY                 I SET_INPLACE                   Inplace view                                                .
IF_IOS_FACTORY                 I SET_XMLSOURCE                 set xmlsource for spreadsheet,refers to generic ALVXML      .
IF_IOS_SPREADSHEET             I ACTIVATEXMLSOURCE             Generic ALV xml source is embedded                          .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I AUTOFIXING_CREATE             Automatic Interest Fixing                                   .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I AUTOFIXING_REVERSE            Automatic Reversal of Interest Fixing                       .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I DATES_IN_PROCESS              Fixing Dates in Process                                     .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I FIXING_PROPOSE                Determine Proposal Values for Fixing                        .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I FIXING_UPDATE                 Sets New Status of Fixing Entry                             .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I FOLLOWING_WORK_MODE           Mode Following Processing Mode                              .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I FRA_CALC_POSSIBLE             New Calculation Possible for FRA?                           .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I GET_BEARER_CAT                Reads Bearer_cat                                            .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I GET_BEARER_ID                 Reads Bearer_ID                                             .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I GET_MODUS                     Reads Mode Attribute                                        .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I GET_TRIGGER                   Reads Trigger Attribute                                     .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I INTEREST_VALUES_GET           Delivers int. rates acc. to planned record update strategy  .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I IS_FIXING_EDITABLE            Determines if Editing is Possible                           .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I LAST_IRA_DATE_GET             Delivers Date of Last Fixing                                .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_CHECK           Checks Registration Entries                                 .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_DEACTIVATE      Deactivates Registrations                                   .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_GET             Reads Status of Registrations                               .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_REACTIVATE      Reactivates Registrations                                   .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_REVERSE         Sets all Existing Registrations to Obsolete                 .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_SAVE            Saves Registrations with Interest Rate Adjustment Bearer    .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I REGISTRATIONS_UPDATE          Sets New Status of Registrations                            .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I SET_CASHFLOW_ID               Sets Cash Flow ID to be Processed                           .
IF_IRA_BEARER                  I SET_REGI_STATE_OUT_OF_PROCESS Removes Registrations from Processing                       .
IF_IRA_CFOWNER                 I CASHFLOW_GET                  Calculate Cash Flow                                         .
IF_IRA_CFOWNER                 I CHECK                         Complete Check of Cash Flow Bearer                          .
IF_IRA_CFOWNER                 I FIXING_RUN                    Execute Fixing Activity                                     .
IF_IRA_CFOWNER                 I HEADER_GET                    Determine Screen Data of Header                             .
IF_IRA_CFOWNER                 I SAVE                          Save Cash Flow Bearer                                       .
IF_IRA_GUI                     I AUTOREFRESH_SET               Set Automatic Update of Display                             .
IF_IRA_GUI                     I COLLECT                       Collect Data                                                .
IF_IRA_GUI                     I DISPLAY                       Display Data                                                .
IF_IRA_GUI                     I DISPLAY_FREE                  Exit Display                                                .
IF_IRA_GUI                     I DISPLAY_INIT                  Display for First Time                                      .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I AREAS_BUFFER                  Read the catalog areas and buffer them locally              .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I AREAS_CLEAR                   Clear the area buffer                                       .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I AREAS_GET                     Returns the table of buffered areas                         .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I ATTRIBUTE_NAMES_GET           Get all attribute names and types                           .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I IPC_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES_GET      Read standard attributes relevant for IPC pricing           .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I ITEMS_BUFFER                  Read the catalog items and buffer them locally              .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I ITEMS_CLEAR                   Clear the item buffer                                       .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I ITEMS_GET                     Returns the table of buffered items                         .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I LANGUAGE_GET                  Determines the language of the catalog variant              .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I NODE_GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES     Get the additional attribute values for an area or an item  .
IF_ISA_REPLICATION_CATALOG     I NODE_GET_DETAILS              Get description and images for an area or an item           .
IF_ISE_CALLBACK                I ON_EVENT_RAISED               Event Was Triggered                                         .
IF_ISE_CALLBACK_STATIC         I ON_EVENT_RAISED               Event Was Triggered (Static Handler)                        .
IF_ISE_SENDER                  I GET_EVENT_DATA                Get Event Data                                              .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT_TMPL  I AFTER_EXIT_AT_AGAIN           After Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item              .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT_TMPL  I AFTER_EXIT_AT_FIRST           Method After Execution for First Call of Base Item          .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT_TMPL  I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_AGAIN          Method Before Execution for Repeated Call of Base Item      .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEMS_EXIT_TMPL  I BEFORE_EXIT_AT_FIRST          Method Before Execution for First Call of Base Item         .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEM_CHECK_CB    I CHECK_CALLBACK                Check Special Base Item Data (Callback Procedure)           .
IF_ISHMED_BASEITEM_CTS_FACTORY I GET_CTS_OBJECT                Creates CTS Object                                          .
IF_ISHMED_CNTNAVIGATOR_OBJECT  I REFRESH                       Refresh View                                                .
IF_ISHMED_COLLECTION           I ITERATOR                      Create Iterator                                             .
IF_ISHMED_CTS                  I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Return Object Key for Complete Transport                    .
IF_ISHMED_DIALOG               I CALL_F4                       Call Input Help (F4)                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DIALOG               I CHECK                         Perform Check                                               .
IF_ISHMED_DIALOG               I GET_CURSOR_POSITION           Cursor Position                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DIALOG               I GET_POSITION                  Determine Dialog Box Position                               .
IF_ISHMED_DIALOG               I GET_TITLE                     Determine Title                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DISPATCHER           I SEND_OBJECT                   Dispatches an Object                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT_DESC     I GET_CONTENT_FORMAT            Returns Content Format                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT_DESC     I GET_FILE_EXTENSION            Returns File Name Extension, if Known                       .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT_DESC     I GET_MIME_TYPE                 Returns Mime Type Suited to Content (if Exists)             .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT_DESC     I IS_BINARY_CONTENT             Returns Whether Content Part Is a Binary Data Block         .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_CONTENT_DESC     I IS_XML_CONTENT                Returns Whether It Concerns XML Content                     .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_CTRLAREA  I SHOW_AS_CONTROL               Displays Document in a Control Area                         .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_DIALOG    I COPY                          Copy document                                               .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_DIALOG    I CREATE                        Create Document                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_DIALOG    I SHOW_DIALOG                   Change/Display Document                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_PRINT     I PRINT                         Print Document                                              .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_SCREEN_PRINT     I SHOW_PRINT_VIEW               Display Document in Print Preview                           .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_CTX           I CB_PROPAGATE_UCOMM            CALLBACK: Forward OK Code                                   .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_CTX           I CB_SET_SCREEN_ENV             CALLBACK: Set Screen Environment Data                       .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_ENV           I CB_PROCESS_NEXT_REQUEST       CALLBACK: Process Next Request in Command Queue             .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_ENV           I CB_PROPAGATE_UCOMM            CALLBACK: Forward OK Code                                   .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_ENV           I CB_SET_SCREEN_ENV             CALLBACK: Set Screen Environment Data                       .
IF_ISHMED_DOC_WP_ENV           I CB_UCOMM_ACCEPTED             CALLBACK: OK Code Processed                                 .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_CAT            I READ_CAT_LIST                 Determine Catalog Entries                                   .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I CLOSE                         Close                                                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I DESTROY                       Destroy                                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_AREA                      Get Application Area                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_ID                        Get Key                                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_NAME                      Get Name                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_NOTE                      Get Note                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_SHORT_CODE                Get Identification                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_STATE                     Get Status                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_TEMPLATE_ID               Get Template Key                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_TEXT                      Get SAPscript Text                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_TEXT_AS_STRING            Get SAPscript Text as String                                .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I GET_TEXT_PROPERTIES           Get Object Type of SAPscript Text                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I IS_CHANGED                    Changed?                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I IS_DELETED                    Deleted?                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I IS_NEW                        New?                                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I IS_READONLY                   Read-Only?                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I REFRESH                       Reload from Database                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I SET_NOTE                      Enter Note                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I SET_READONLY                  Write Protection On "-" Off                                 .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I SNAP                          Snapshot                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_OBJECT         I UNDO                          Retrieve Snapshot                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_AREA                      Get Application Area                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_ID                        Get Key                                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_NAME                      Get Name                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_SHORT_CODE                Get Identification                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_TEXT_AS_STRING            Get SAPscript Text as String                                .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I GET_TYPE                      Get Type                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I IS_VALID                      Is Object Valid?                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_READER         I REFRESH                       Load from Database                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_SDEF_DRAG_DROP I SET_TARGET                    Set Target Information                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_USAGE_COUNT    I GET_USAGE_COUNT               Get List of Users                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWSWL_WHERE_USED     I GET_USE_LIST                  Get List of Users                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I ADD_SUBAREA                   Add DWS Subarea to DWS Area                                 .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I GET_SUBAREA                   Return DWS Subarea                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I HIDE_SUBAREAS                 Hide Selected DWS Subareas                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I LINK                          Connect Area Controls to a Screen                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I REMOVE_SUBAREA                Delete DWS Subarea from DWS Area                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA             I SHOW_SUBAREAS                 Display Selected DWS Subareas                               .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I FINALIZE                      Destroy DWS Element/Release Resources                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I GET_CHILD_CONTROL             Returns Embedded Control                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I GET_LAYOUT                    Creates Layout Object                                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I HIDE                          Set DWS Element Invisible                                   .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I IS_VISIBLE                    Is the Interface Element Visible?                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I REFRESH                       Refresh DWS Element                                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I RESET                         Set DWS Element to Initial Values                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I SET_LAYOUT                    Evaluates Layout Object                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I SET_SCREEN_ENV                Sets Area GUI Parameter                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_AREA_ELEMENT     I SHOW                          Display DWS Element                                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CALLBACKRESPONSE I CALLBACK_RESPONSE             Callback of Event Object                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CB_EXCEPTION     I PROPAGATE                     Propogate Exception                                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I FINALIZE                      End Handling: Release Resources                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Component Attribute                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I HIDE                          Hide Component                                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Component                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I LOAD                          Loads a DWS Component into Work Station                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I LOAD_INVISIBLE                Loads an Invisible DWS Component into Work Station          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I REFRESH                       Read Data Again and Refresh Display                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I REFRESH_DISPLAY               Display Components or Refresh Display                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_COMP             I UNLOAD                        Unloads a DWS Component                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CONTEXT_OBJECT   I IS_LOCKED                     DWS Context Object Locked?                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CONTEXT_OBJECT   I LOCK                          Lock DWS Context Object                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CONTEXT_OBJECT   I RELEASE_FOCUS                 Undo Focus                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CONTEXT_OBJECT   I SET_FOCUS                     Activate DWS Context Object (Set Focus)                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_CONTEXT_OBJECT   I UNLOCK                        Release Lock on DWS Context Object                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_DYNAMIC_REQ      I BIND_CHANGING                 Binds Data Object to Change Interface                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_DYNAMIC_REQ      I BIND_EXPORTING                Binds Data Object to Export Interface                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_DYNAMIC_REQ      I BIND_IMPORTING                Binds Data Object to Import Interface                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_DYNAMIC_REQ      I BIND_OBJECT                   Binds Object to Call Parameter                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_DYNAMIC_REQ      I BIND_RECEIVING                Binds Data Object to Return Interface                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I BROADCAST                     Send Broadcast                                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I DEREGISTER                    Deregister Documentation Object                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I DEREGISTER_SERVICE            Deregister Service                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I DISPATCH                      Send Message to Recipient                                   .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I REGISTER                      Register Documentation Object                               .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_FRAMEWORK        I REGISTER_SERVICE              Register Service                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I ACTIVATE                      Activate Work Area                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I CHANGE                        Edit Document                                               .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I CHECK                         Consistency Check                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I CLOSE                         End Dialog                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I CREATE                        Create Document                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivate Work Area                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I DELETE                        Delete Document                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I DISPLAY                       Display Document                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I FINALIZE                      End Handling; Release Resources                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I IS_CHANGED                    Was the Document Data Changed?                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I PRINT                         Print Document                                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I PRINT_PREVIEW                 Print Preview                                               .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I PROCESS_INPUT                 For Dynpro: Evaluate PAI                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SAVE                          Save Document                                               .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SET_CURSOR                    Set Cursor in Document                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SET_LOCAL_FUNCTIONS           Define Document-Related Function Code (Toolbar)             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SET_MODE                      Move Document to Display/Processing Mode                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SET_SCREEN_ENV                Determine Window Environment of Document; for Screen: PBO   .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SET_WORKAREA                  Creates/Returns Abstract Work Area (Singleton)              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_OBJECTTYPE       I SYNC_SCREEN_TO_DATA           For Screen: Trigger Field Transport                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PB_OBJECT        I FINALIZE                      End Handling: Release Resources                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PB_OBJECT        I GET_PROPERTY                  Reads a Property                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PB_OBJECT        I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets a Property                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I CHECK                         Consistency Check                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks for Changes                                          .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I COLLECT_MESSAGES              Collect Error Messages                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I DESTROY                       Destroys the Object                                         .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I GET_SCREEN_ATTRIBUTES         Returns Interface Properties of DWS Process                 .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Object                                      .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I SAVE                          Saves the Data                                              .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I SET_CURSOR                    Sets Cursor Position                                        .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I SET_UCOMM                     Sets the User Command                                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I SET_VCODE                     Sets the Processing Mode                                    .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_PROCESS          I USER_COMMAND                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_REQUEST          I SEND                          Sends Request to Broker                                     .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_SEMOBJS          I GET_ISH_OBJECT_TYPE           Determines IS-H Object Type                                 .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_SUBAREA          I FINALIZE                      Display Subarea/Release Resources                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_SUBAREA          I HIDE                          Subarea Invisible                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_SUBAREA          I REFRESH                       Refresh Subarea                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_SUBAREA          I SHOW                          Display Subarea                                             .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_VIEW             I CREATE                        Create a DWS View                                           .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_VIEW             I DISPLAY                       Display DWS View                                            .
IF_ISHMED_DWS_VIEW             I REFRESH                       Refresh DWS View                                            .
IF_ISHMED_FO_PRINTABLE         I GET_IMAGES                    Determine Image Data of Link Element                        .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I BROADCAST_CHANGE              Disclose Change of Context Object                           .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I CLEAR_CONTEXT                 Empties Context                                             .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I CLEAR_DATA                    Deletes Object from Context                                 .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I FINALIZE                      Finalize Object                                             .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_CASE                      Reads Case                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_DATA                      Read Object                                                 .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns Instance of Environment                             .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_INSTITUTION               Reads Institution                                           .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_MOVEMENT                  Reads Movement                                              .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_PATIENT                   Reads Patient Number                                        .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_SINGLE_DATA               Return Object in Type-Related Field                         .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I GET_TREE_COPY                 Create Copy of Tree                                         .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I SET_CASE                      Sets Case                                                   .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I SET_DATA                      Write Object                                                .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I SET_MOVEMENT                  Sets Movement                                               .
IF_ISHMED_GENERAL_CTX          I SET_PATIENT                   Sets Patient Number                                         .
IF_ISHMED_GET_AO_HANDLING      I GET_REF_AO_HANDLING           Determine Instance for Processing Appointment Proposals     .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I CREATE                        Generate Persistent Object                                  .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I DELETE                        Delete Persistent Object                                    .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I DEQUEUE_BY_KEY                Lift Database Lock with Business Key                        .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I ENQUEUE_BY_KEY                Set Database Lock with Business Key                         .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I GET_STRUCTURE_NAME            Determine Name of Transfer Structure                        .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I IS_CHANGED                    Check on Call                                               .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I LOAD                          Load Persistent Object                                      .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_AGENT        I REFRESH                       Update from DB                                              .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_SUBTYPE      I CHECK                         Check Data                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_SUBTYPE      I GET_FIELD                     Read Field                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_SUBTYPE      I GET_KEY_STRING                Determine Key String                                        .
IF_ISHMED_GL_BASE_SUBTYPE      I SET_FIELD                     Set Field                                                   .
IF_ISHMED_GL_CTS               I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Return Object Key for CTS                                   .
IF_ISHMED_GL_LOCK              I DEQUEUE                       Lift DB Lock                                                .
IF_ISHMED_GL_LOCK              I ENQUEUE                       Set DB Lock                                                 .
IF_ISHMED_GL_MASTER_DATA       I CHECK_EXTENDED                Perform Extended Check of Object                            .
IF_ISHMED_GL_MASTER_DATA       I CHECK_ON_ACTIVATION           Check at Activation                                         .
IF_ISHMED_GL_TEXT              I CREATE_CLONE                  Create Duplicate                                            .
IF_ISHMED_GL_TEXT              I CREATE_ON_USE                 Create if Required (Spec. as Text)                          .
IF_ISHMED_GL_TEXT              I GET_TEXT_ID                   Determine Text ID                                           .
IF_ISHMED_GL_TEXT              I GET_TEXT_KEY                  Determine Text Key                                          .
IF_ISHMED_GL_USE_TEXT          I GET_HEADER                    Return Key Data                                             .
IF_ISHMED_GL_USE_TEXT          I GET_TEXT                      Retrieve Other than SAPscript Text                          .
IF_ISHMED_GL_USE_TEXT          I SET_TEXT                      Set Other than SAPscript Text                               .
IF_ISHMED_GL_WHERE_USE         I WHERE_USED                    Determine Use                                               .
IF_ISHMED_GL_WHERE_USE         I WHERE_USED_RUNTIME            Determine Use for Runtime                                   .
IF_ISHMED_GL_WHERE_USE         I WHERE_USED_RUNTIME_DEEP       Determine Deep Use at Runtime                               .
IF_ISHMED_ITERATOR             I GET_NEXT                      Get Next Element                                            .
IF_ISHMED_ITERATOR             I HAS_NEXT                      Further Object Exists                                       .
IF_ISHMED_LOCK_SPECIAL         I LOCK_DEQUEUE                  Remove Lock                                                 .
IF_ISHMED_LOCK_SPECIAL         I LOCK_ENQUEUE                  Set Lock                                                    .
IF_ISHMED_LOCK_SPECIAL         I LOCK_GET_DATA                 Determine Attributes for Lock                               .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I CHANGE                        Change Object Attributes                                    .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I CHECK                         Check object                                                .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check for Changes in Object                                 .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I CREATE                        Create Instance of New Object                               .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I DESTROY                       Destroy Object                                              .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I GET_DATA                      Return Object Data                                          .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I GET_KEY_STRING                Determine Character String of Object                        .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I GET_TYPE                      Return Type of Object                                       .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object (i.e. Internal Attributes)                .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I IS_CANCELLED                  Is Object Canceled?                                         .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I IS_IN_DATABASE                Is the Object Data Already in the Database?                 .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I IS_NEW                        Is Object New? (Method Faster than GET_DATA!)               .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I LOAD                          Create Instance of an Object (that Exists in the Database)  .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I REFRESH                       Refresh Object                                              .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I SAVE                          Update Object                                               .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I SNAPSHOT                      Temporarily Hold Object Content (also See UNDO)             .
IF_ISHMED_MASTER_DATA          I UNDO                          Reactivate Content of Object Held with SNAPSHOT             .
IF_ISHMED_ME_DRUGID_CHANGE     I CHECK_FOR_DRUG_CHANGE         Actions If Drug ID (or Drug Name) Changed                   .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Attributes                                       .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I PERFORM_DEFAULT_SEL           Execute Default Selection                                   .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I REPLACE_SCREEN                Replace Standard Screen                                     .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I SET_DEFAULT_SEL               Define Default Selection in Event Grid                      .
IF_ISHMED_ME_EVENT_LIST        I TRANSPORT_TO_DATA             PAI: Processing after Field Transports and befor OK_CODE    .
IF_ISHMED_ME_ORDER_DIALOG_ADDO I SAVE_AFTER                    Method AFTER Saving, BEFORE Commit                          .
IF_ISHMED_ME_ORDER_DIALOG_ADDO I SAVE_BEFORE                   Method BEFORE Saving                                        .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I CREATE                        Factory Method                                              .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I DISPLAY                       Display List on Screen                                      .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I GET_VIEW_DATA                 Get List Data                                               .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I PRINT                         Print list                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I PRINT_LABELS                  Print Labels                                                .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I SET_DATA                      Set List Data                                               .
IF_ISHMED_ME_PL_VIEW           I SHOW_PROGRESS                 Calculate Progress Display                                  .
IF_ISHMED_ME_SCR_EXP           I CONVERT_SCREEN_ERROR          Internal Screen Error: Convert Field Name, etc.             .
IF_ISHMED_ME_SCR_EXP           I GET_FIELD_PROP_CUSTOM         Set Field Properties of Screen                              .
IF_ISHMED_ME_SCR_EXP           I SET_SPECIAL_ATTRIB            Transfer Special (Customer Specific) Attributes             .
IF_ISHMED_ME_WARNING_HANDLER   I HANDLE_WARNINGS               Handle Warnings                                             .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I BUILD_LINE_KEY                Create Line Key for Standard Data Record                    .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I GET_DATA_FIELD                Return One Single Data Field                                .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I GET_TYPE                      Return Type of Object                                       .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object (i.e. Internal Attributes)                .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I REFRESH                       Refresh Object                                              .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I SNAPSHOT                      Temporarily Hold Object Content (also See UNDO)             .
IF_ISHMED_NONE_OO_DATA         I UNDO                          Activate Content of Object Noted with "Snapshot"            .
IF_ISHMED_PATORG_REQUEST       I SELECT                        IS-H*MED: Physical Reading of Requests                      .
IF_ISHMED_PLAN                 I AFTER_CHANGE                  Data were changed; Repeated Adaption/Change Possible        .
IF_ISHMED_PMD_LINK             I LINK__CALL_METHOD             Dynamic Method Call                                         .
IF_ISHMED_PMD_LINK             I LINK__CHECK_CHANGES           Data changed?                                               .
IF_ISHMED_PMD_LINK             I LINK__FREE                    Destructor                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_PMD_LINK             I LINK__SAVE                    Save Link Objects                                           .
IF_ISHMED_PMD_LINK             I LINK__SET_PROPERTY            Set General Characteristic                                  .
IF_ISHMED_PRC_PLANNING         I GET_PRC_DATA_MED              Get Return Values                                           .
IF_ISHMED_PRC_PLANNING         I GET_USE_DEFAULT_CAUSE_CHANGE  Get 'Use Default Reason' Global Attribute                   .
IF_ISHMED_PRC_PLANNING         I PLANNING_MED                  Execute Planning (With/Without Dialog)                      .
IF_ISHMED_PRC_PLANNING         I SET_PRC_DATA_MED              Transfer Relevant Data for Planning Process                 .
IF_ISHMED_PRC_PLANNING         I SET_USE_DEFAULT_CAUSE_CHANGE  Set 'Use Default Reason' Global Attribute                   .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP          I CLEAR                         Deletes Class Attributes According to Type                  .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP          I FINALIZE                      Treatment End: Releases Allocated Resources                 .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP          I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Attribute                                              .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP          I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Class Attributes                                .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_ATTRMAP          I SET_PROPERTY                  Set Attribute                                               .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I ABOUT                         Output an About-message                                     .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I CHECK_SELECTED_ITEMS          Check Consistency of Selection                              .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I COLLAPSE_ALL_NODES            Closes Entire Structure                                     .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I DO_ACTION                     Execute Definable Action/Command                            .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I EXPAND_ALL                    Opens Entire Structure                                      .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I GET_SEL_ENTRY                 Supplies the Selected Entry                                 .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I GET_SEL_LEIST                 Returns the Selected Services                               .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I LOAD_STUDY_FROM_LNRLS         Execute Load Study for a Service Number                     .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I RAISE_SELECTION_CHANGED       Fires 'Item Selection Has Changed' Event                    .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I RECALL_SEL_LEIST              Recalls the Selection of the Services                       .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I REFRESH_DISPLAY               Refresh view                                                .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I REFRESH_WL                    Refreshes Display and Worklist                              .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_COLUMNS_WIDTH             Set Column Widths                                           .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_COL_HEADING               Set Column Headings                                         .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_CONFIGURATION             Changes the Configuration                                   .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_DISABLE                   Disable Control Boxes (Tree)                                .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_DOKNR_FOR_LNRLS           Sets the Document Number for the Selected Services          .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_ENABLE                    Enable All Control Boxes (Tree)                             .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_ITEM                      Change Entry                                                .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_NODE_DEFAULT              Set Display of the Transferred Service to DEFAULT Style     .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_NODE_EMPHASIZED           Set Display of the Transferred Service to EMPHASIZED Style  .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SET_VISIBLE                   Set the Display Status                                      .
IF_ISHMED_RAD_PROC_WKL         I SHOW_STUDY_QUICK_VIEW         Show the Study Quick View                                   .
IF_ISHMED_RECIPIENT            I EQUALS                        Checks Whether Other Object Refers to Same Recipient        .
IF_ISHMED_RECIPIENT            I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns a Displayable Description of Recipient              .
IF_ISHMED_RECIPIENT            I GET_TRANSPORT_VARIANT         Returns Which Transport Route Is to Be Used                 .
IF_ISHMED_RECIPIENT            I INIT_FROM_DIALOG              Opens Popup for Initial Selection of a New Partner          .
IF_ISHMED_RECIPIENT            I SHOW_EDIT_DIALOG              Opens Popup to Process Partner Entry                        .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Diagnosis Attributes                                        .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I BAPI_CHECK                    Check Consistency                                           .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I BAPI_GETLIST                  Diagnosis Data                                              .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DIAGNOSIS_AUTHORITY_INFO      Authorizations for Single Diagnoses                         .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DIAGNOSIS_BY_LFDNR            Saved Diagnosis via LFDNR                                   .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DIAGNOSIS_CANCEL              Cancel All Diagnoses for the Case                           .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DIAGNOSIS_CREATE              Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DOCVIEWS_GET                  Department Stays for the Case                               .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DOCVIEW_GET                   Department Stay for Movement                                .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DRG_GROUPER_EXPORT            Export Diagnoses to Grouper                                 .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DRG_GROUPER_IMPORT            Import Diagnoses From Grouper                               .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I DRG_GROUPER_RESET             Reset DRG Indicator                                         .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I MEDICAL_DATA_PROOF            Code Check                                                  .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I MODE_SET                      Access Mode (Also for Dependent Objects)                    .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I PARAMS_GET                    Diagnosis Parameters                                        .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSES           I SECTIONS_FOR_VIEW             Department Stays for View                                   .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I BAPI_CANCEL                   Cancel Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I BAPI_CHANGE                   Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I BAPI_GETDETAIL                Diagnosis Data for BAPI                                     .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I DOCVIEW_GET                   Call Department Reference                                   .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I ICD10_LINK_RELEASE            Delete Primary Diagnosis                                    .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I ICD10_PRIMARY_GET             Primary Diagnosis                                           .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I ICD10_PRIMARY_SET             Set Primary Diagnosis                                       .
IF_ISH_CASEDIAGNOSIS           I LFDNR_SET                     Set Sequence Number                                         .
IF_ISH_CHANGEDOCUMENT          I GET_CHANGEDOCUMENT            Returns All Fields with Change Documents                    .
IF_ISH_CM_EL                   I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns a Unique Instance of the Event Handler              .
IF_ISH_CM_EL                   I OBJ_EVENT_NOTICE_T            Gets Event Coll. Sent by Event Manager                      .
IF_ISH_CM_OBJ                  I ID_GET                        Delivers Object ID                                          .
IF_ISH_CM_OBJ                  I TYPE_GET                      Delivers Object Type                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I CANCEL                        Cancels the Data of the Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I CHECK                         Checks                                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks if Changes Made                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I CONFIGURE                     Configuration of the Component                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I COPY_DATA                     Copies the Data from Another Component                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I CREATE                        Creates and Returns a Component Object                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I DESTROY                       Destroys the Component Instance                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I DESTROY_SCREENS               Destroys All Screen Instances of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_CALLER                    Returns the Calling Program                                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_COMPDEF                   Returns Corresponding Component Definition                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_COMPID                    Returns the COMPID of the Related Component Definition      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_COMPNAME                  Returns the Short Description of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration Object                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_DATA                      Determine the Data of a Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_DEFINED_SCREENS           Returns All Screen Instances                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns the Environment                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_EXTERN_METHODS            Determine All Defined Methods Including Description         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_HIDE                      Hide Component?                                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_LOCK                      Returns the Lock Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Retursn the Main Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_OBTYP                     Returns the OBTYP of the Component                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_REFRESHED                 Returns whether the Component Was Refreshed                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_T_RUN_DATA                Returns a List of All Data Objects of the Component         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_T_UID                     Returns All UIDs for this Component                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I GET_VCODE                     Returns the Current VCODE                                   .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I HAS_CONFIGURATION             Has Component Configuration?                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of a Component                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I IS_BEWTY_SUPPORTED            Retursn Whether Movement Category Is Supported              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I IS_EMPTY                      Returns Whether Module Data Exists                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I IS_OP                         Returns Whether Object Is a Surgery Component               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I IS_SCREEN_SUPPORTED           Returns Whether a Screen Is Supported                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I PREALLOC                      Make Presettings                                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I PREALLOC_FROM_EXTERNAL        Preset Clinical Order from an XML Document                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I PROCESS_METHOD                Execute Method                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I REFRESH                       Refresh Component Data                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SAVE                          Saves the Data of the Component                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_CALLER                    Sets the Calling Program                                    .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_CONFIG                    Sets the Configuration Object                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data to a Component                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_ENVIRONMENT               Sets the Environment                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_HIDE                      Hide Component ON/OFF                                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_LOCK                      Sets the Lock Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_MAIN_OBJECT               Sets the Main Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_REFRESHED                 Sets the Indicator for Update                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_T_UID                     Sets All UIDs for this Component                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I SET_VCODE                     Sets the VCODE                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I TRANSPORT_FROM_SCREEN         Data Transport of Screen(s) into Data Objects               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT               I TRANSPORT_TO_SCREEN           Data Transport of Data Objects into Screen(s)               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I CANCEL                        Cancels the Data of the Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I CHECK                         Checks                                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks if Changes Made                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I COPY_DATA                     Copies the Data from Another Component                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I DESTROY                       Destroys the Component Instance                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I DESTROY_SCREENS               Destroys All Screen Instances of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_CALLER                    Returns the Calling Program                                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_COMPDEF                   Returns Corresponding Component Definition                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_COMPID                    Returns the COMPID of the Related Component Definition      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_COMPNAME                  Returns the Short Description of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_COMPONENT_CONFIG          Returns the Component Configuration                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration Object                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_DATA                      Determine the Data of a Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_DEFINED_SCREENS           Returns All Screen Instances                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns the Environment                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_LOCK                      Returns the Lock Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Retursn the Main Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_OBTYP                     Returns the OBTYP of the Component                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_REFRESHED                 Returns whether the Component Was Refreshed                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_T_RUN_DATA                Returns a List of All Data Objects of the Component         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_T_UID                     Returns All UIDs for this Component                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I GET_VCODE                     Returns the Current VCODE                                   .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of a Component                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I IS_EMPTY                      Returns Whether Component Data Exists                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I IS_SCREEN_SUPPORTED           Returns Whether a Screen Is Supported                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I PREALLOC                      Make Presettings                                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I PROCESS_EV_SYSTEM_EVENT       Handling of Screen Event EV_SYSTEM_EVENT                    .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I PROCESS_UCOMM                 Handling of a User Command                                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I REFRESH                       Refresh Component Data                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SAVE                          Saves the Data of the Component                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_CALLER                    Sets the Calling Program                                    .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_COMPCON_XML_DOCUMENT      Sets the Component Configuration Data                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_COMPCON_XML_ELEMENT       Sets the Component Configuration Data                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_CONFIG                    Sets the Configuration Object                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data to a Component                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_ENVIRONMENT               Sets the Environment                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_LOCK                      Sets the Lock Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_MAIN_OBJECT               Sets the Main Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_REFRESHED                 Sets the Indicator for Update                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_T_UID                     Sets All UIDs for this Component                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I SET_VCODE                     Sets the VCODE                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I TRANSPORT_FROM_SCREEN         Transport Data from Screen(s) into Data Objects             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE          I TRANSPORT_TO_SCREEN           Transport Data from Data Objects into Screen(s)             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I CANCEL                        Cancels the Data of the Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I CHECK                         Checks                                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks if Changes Made                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I COPY_DATA                     Copies the Data from Another Component                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I CREATE_BASE                   Creates and Returns a Component Object                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I DESTROY                       Destroys the Component Instance                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I DESTROY_SCREENS               Destroys All Screen Instances of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_CALLER                    Returns the Calling Program                                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_COMPDEF                   Returns Corresponding Component Definition                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_COMPID                    Returns the COMPID of the Related Component Definition      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_COMPNAME                  Returns the Short Description of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration Object                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_DATA                      Determine the Data of a Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_DEFINED_SCREENS           Returns All Screen Instances                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns the Environment                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_LOCK                      Returns the Lock Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Retursn the Main Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_OBTYP                     Returns the OBTYP of the Component                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_REFRESHED                 Returns whether the Component Was Refreshed                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_T_RUN_DATA                Returns a List of All Data Objects of the Component         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_T_UID                     Returns All UIDs for this Component                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I GET_VCODE                     Returns the Current VCODE                                   .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I HAS_CONFIGURATION             Has Component Configuration?                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of a Component                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I IS_BEWTY_SUPPORTED            Retursn Whether Movement Category Is Supported              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I IS_EMPTY                      Returns Whether Module Data Exists                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I IS_OP                         Returns Whether Object Is a Surgery Component               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I IS_SCREEN_SUPPORTED           Returns Whether a Screen Is Supported                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I PREALLOC                      Make Presettings                                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I PROCESS_METHOD                Execute Method                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I REFRESH                       Refresh Component Data                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SAVE                          Saves the Data of the Component                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_CALLER                    Sets the Calling Program                                    .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_CONFIG                    Sets the Configuration Object                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data to a Component                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_ENVIRONMENT               Sets the Environment                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_LOCK                      Sets the Lock Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_MAIN_OBJECT               Sets the Main Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_REFRESHED                 Sets the Indicator for Update                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_T_UID                     Sets All UIDs for this Component                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I SET_VCODE                     Sets the VCODE                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I TRANSPORT_FROM_SCREEN         Transport Data from Screen(s) into Data Objects             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_BASE_ORIG     I TRANSPORT_TO_SCREEN           Transport Data from Data Objects into Screen(s)             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I AS_XML_DOCUMENT               Returns the Object as XML Document                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I AS_XML_ELEMENT                Returns the Object as XML Element                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I CHECK                         Checks the Object                                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks if Changes Exist                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I DESTROY                       Destroys the Object                                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I GET_COMPONENT                 Returns the Component of the Object                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I GET_SCREEN                    Returns the Interface of the Object                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Object                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I RESET_DATA                    Reset to Original Data                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I SET_DATA_BY_XML_DOCUMENT      Sets the Component Configuration Data                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I SET_DATA_BY_XML_ELEMENT       Sets the Component Configuration Data                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_CONFIG        I SHOW_POPUP                    Sends Component Configuration in a Dialog Box               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I CANCEL                        Cancels the Data of the Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I CHECK                         Checks                                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Checks if Changes Made                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I CONFIGURE                     Configuration of the Component                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I COPY_DATA                     Copies the Data from Another Component                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I CREATE                        Creates and Returns a Component Object                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I DESTROY                       Destroys the Component Instance                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I DESTROY_SCREENS               Destroys All Screen Instances of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_CALLER                    Returns the Calling Program                                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_COMPDEF                   Returns Corresponding Component Definition                  .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_COMPID                    Returns the COMPID of the Related Component Definition      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_COMPNAME                  Returns the Short Description of the Component              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration Object                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_DATA                      Determine the Data of a Component                           .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_DEFINED_SCREENS           Returns All Screen Instances                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns the Environment                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_EXTERN_METHODS            Determine All Defined Methods Including Description         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_LOCK                      Returns the Lock Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Retursn the Main Object                                     .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_OBTYP                     Returns the OBTYP of the Component                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_REFRESHED                 Returns whether the Component Was Refreshed                 .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_T_RUN_DATA                Returns a List of All Data Objects of the Component         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_T_UID                     Returns All UIDs for this Component                         .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I GET_VCODE                     Returns the Current VCODE                                   .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I HAS_CONFIGURATION             Has Component Configuration?                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of a Component                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I IS_BEWTY_SUPPORTED            Retursn Whether Movement Category Is Supported              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I IS_EMPTY                      Returns Whether Module Data Exists                          .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I IS_OP                         Returns Whether Object Is a Surgery Component               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I IS_SCREEN_SUPPORTED           Returns Whether a Screen Is Supported                       .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I PREALLOC                      Make Presettings                                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I PROCESS_METHOD                Execute Method                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I REFRESH                       Refresh Component Data                                      .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SAVE                          Saves the Data of the Component                             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_CALLER                    Sets the Calling Program                                    .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_CONFIG                    Sets the Configuration Object                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_DATA                      Transfer Data to a Component                                .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_ENVIRONMENT               Sets the Environment                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_LOCK                      Sets the Lock Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_MAIN_OBJECT               Sets the Main Object                                        .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_REFRESHED                 Sets the Indicator for Update                               .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_T_UID                     Sets All UIDs for this Component                            .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I SET_VCODE                     Sets the VCODE                                              .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I TRANSPORT_FROM_SCREEN         Transport Data from Screen(s) into Data Objects             .
IF_ISH_COMPONENT_ORIG          I TRANSPORT_TO_SCREEN           Transport Data from Data Objects into Screen(s)             .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I CHANGE_FUNCTIONS              Change Functions                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I CHECK                         Execute Checks                                              .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I CHECK_SCR_FIELD_VALUES        Checks Formal Correctness of Screen Fields                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I CHECK_SCR_MANDATORY_FIELDS    Checks Required-Entry Fields of a Screen                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I CREATE_LISTBOX                Create and Fill List Box                                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I FILL_LABEL                    Fill Generated Text Field                                   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_CONFIG_ALV_GRID           Returns the Configuration Object for ALV Grid Screen        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_CONFIG_ALV_TREE           Returns the Configuration Object for ALV Tree Screen        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_CONFIG_HTML               Returns the Configuration Object for HTML                   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_CONFIG_SPLITTER           Returns the Configuration Object for Splitter Screens       .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_CURSOR_START_POSITION     Determine Initial Position of Cursor                        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_DEFAULT_CURSORFIELD       Returns the Field Name for Standard Cursor Position         .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_DIALOG_POSITION           Determine Dialog's Position                                 .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_HANDLE_MANDATORY_FIELDS   Returns Flag whether Rqrd-Entry Fields of Screen Are Handled.
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_TITLE                     Determine Title for Dialog                                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I GET_T_SCRMOD                  Determination of Screen Table with Modifications, Internal  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I HELP_REQUEST                  F1 Documentation                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Change Appearance of the Screen Fields                      .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I OK_CODE                       Transfer OK Code and Possibly Execute Function              .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_CONFIG_ALV_GRID           Sets the Configuration Object for ALV Grid Screens          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_CONFIG_ALV_TREE           Sets the Configuration Object for ALV Tree Screens          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_CONFIG_HTML               Sets the Configuration Object for HTML                      .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_CONFIG_SPLITTER           Sets the Configuratio Object for Splitter Screens           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_CURSOR_START_POSITION     Set Initial Position of the Cursor                          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_DIALOG_POSITION           Set Position of the Dialog                                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_HANDLE_MANDATORY_FIELDS   Sets Flag Whether Rqrd-Entry Fields on Screen Are Handled   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I SET_TITLE                     Set Titel for the Dialog                                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG                  I VALUE_REQUEST                 Input Help                                                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I ADD_MERGE_FIELDS              Add Fields for Cell Merging                                 .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_EXCL_FUNC          Edit Grid Functions to Be Excluded                          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_F4                 Edit F4 Table of the Grid                                   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_FIELDCAT           Edit Field Catalog of the Grid                              .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_FILTER             Edit Filter Criteria of the Grid                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_LAYOUT             Edit Layout of the Grid                                     .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_MENU_BUTTON        Edit Menu Buttons of the Grid                               .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_REFRESH_INFO       Edit Update Information of the Grid                         .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_SORT               Edit Sort Criteria of the Grid                              .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_TOOLBAR            Edit Toolbar of the Grid                                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I BUILD_GRID_VARIANT            Edit Variant of the Grid                                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I HANDLE_ONDRAG                 Process Event ONDRAG of the ALV Grid                        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I HANDLE_ONDROP                 Process Event ONDROP of the ALV Grid                        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I HANDLE_ONDROPCOMPLETE         Process Event ONDROPCOMPLETE of the ALV Grid                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I HANDLE_ONDROPGETFLAVOR        Process Event ONDROPGETFLAVOR of the ALV Grid               .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_BUTTON_CLICK          Process Button Click                                        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_DOUBLE_CLICK          Process Double-Click                                        .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_HOTSPOT_CLICK         Process Hotspot Click                                       .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_PRINT_END_OF_LIST     Process Event PRINT_END_OF_LIST                             .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_PRINT_END_OF_PAGE     Process Event PRINT_END_OF_PAGE                             .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_PRINT_TOP_OF_LIST     Process Event PRINT_TOP_OF_LIST                             .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_PRINT_TOP_OF_PAGE     Process Event PRINT_TOP_OF_PAGE                             .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_SYSEV_BUTTON_CLICK    Process Button Click System Event                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_SYSEV_DOUBLE_CLICK    Process Double-Click System Event                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_SYSEV_HOTSPOT_CLICK   Process Hotspot Click System Event                          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_SYSEV_UCOMM           Process UCOMM System Event                                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I PROCESS_USER_COMMAND          Process UCOMM                                               .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_GRID         I SET_FIELD_FOR_ALT_SELECTION   Defines Fields for the Alternative Selection                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TOOLBAR_EVENTS          Registers Toolbar Events                                    .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_EVENTS             Registers Tree Events                                       .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_EXCL_FUNC          Edit Grid Functions to Be Excluded                          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_FIELDCAT           Edit Tree Field Catalog                                     .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_HIERARCHY_HEADER   Edit Hierarchy Header of ALV Tree                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_LAYOUT             Edit Tree Layout                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_TOOLBAR            Create ALV Tree Toolbar                                     .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I BUILD_TREE_VARIANT            Edit Tree Variant                                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_BEFORE_USER_COMMAND    Process BEFORE_USER_COMMAND Event of ALV Tree               .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DRAG                Process ON_DRAG Event of ALV Tree                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE       Process ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE Event of ALV Tree                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DROP                Process ON_DROP Event of ALV Tree                           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DROP_COMPLETE       Process ON_DROP_COMPLETE Event of ALV Tree                  .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DROP_COMPLETE_MULT  Process ON_DROP_COMPLETE_MULTIPLE Event of ALV Tree         .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I HANDLE_ON_DROP_GET_FLAVOR     Process ON_DROP_GET_FLAVOR Event of ALV Tree                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_EXPAND_NC             Processing of Application Event Expand No Children          .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_FUNC_SELECTED         Processing of Application Event Function Selected           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_ITEM_DC               Processing of Application Event Item Double-Click           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_NODE_DC               Processing of Application Event Node Double-Click           .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_SYSEV_EXPAND_NC       Processing of System Event Expand No Children               .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_SYSEV_FUNC_SEL        Processing of System Event Function Selected                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_SYSEV_ITEM_DC         Processing of System Event Item Double-Click                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_ALV_TREE         I PROCESS_SYSEV_NODE_DC         Processing of System Event Node Double-Click                .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_HTML             I BUILD_DD_DOCUMENT             Create a Dynamic Document                                   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_HTML             I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_HTML             I PROCESS_LINK_CLICKED          Processing of Application Event Click on Link Element       .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_SPLITTER         I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_SPLITTER         I INITIALIZE_COLUMN_PROPERTIES  Initializes the Properties of a Column                      .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_SPLITTER         I INITIALIZE_COMMON_PROPERTIES  Initializes the General Properties of the Splitter Screen   .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_SPLITTER         I INITIALIZE_ROW_PROPERTIES     Initializes the Properties of a Row                         .
IF_ISH_CONFIG_SPLITTER         I MODIFY_PROPERTIES             Modifies the Properties of the Splitter Screen              .
IF_ISH_CORDT_ELEM              I GET_ASS_TYPE                  Supplies the Type of an Element                             .
IF_ISH_CORDT_ELEM              I GET_ELEM_NAME                 Supplies the Description of an Element as a String          .
IF_ISH_CORDT_ELEM              I GET_ELEM_TYPE                 Supplies the Type of an Element as a String                 .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check If Object Has Changed and if so What Has Changed      .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I DESTROY                       Destroy Object                                              .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_CDOC_OBJECT               Returns Change Document Object for Current Object           .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_CHECKING_DATE             Determines Correct Date for Validity Checks                 .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I GET_KEY_STRING                Determine Character String of Object                        .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I IS_ACTIVE                     Is the Object Active? (Method is Faster than GET_DATA!)     .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I IS_CANCELLED                  Is Object Canceled?                                         .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I IS_CHANGED                    Returns Whether the Object Has Changed                      .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I IS_NEW                        Is Object New? (Method Faster than GET_DATA!)               .
IF_ISH_DATA_OBJECT             I REFRESH                       Refresh Object                                              .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I ADMISSION_GET                 Inpatient Case Admission                                    .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I ADMISSION_REASON_GET          Admission Reason                                            .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Case Attributes                                             .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I AUFDT_GET                     Admission Date                                              .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I BUSINESSKEY_GET               DB key                                                      .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I BUSINESSKEY_SET               Assign Case Number                                          .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I CHANGE                        Change Case Data                                            .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I DISCHARGE_GET                 Discharge                                                   .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I DISCHARGE_REASON_GET          Discharge Reason                                            .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I ENTDT_GET                     Discharge Date                                              .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I ESTIMATED_DURATION_GET        Estimated Length of Stay                                    .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I MOVEMENTS_GET                 Movements for Case                                          .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CASE          I MOVEMENT_GET                  Movement via Sequence Number                                .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CATALOGUE     I GET                           Read Diagnosis                                              .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CATALOGUE     I KEY_CHECK                     Check Diagnosis Code                                        .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CATALOGUE     I PREFETCH                      Flag Code for Read                                          .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_CATALOGUE     I REFERENCE_DIAGNOSIS_GET       Determine Reference Diagnosis                               .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_DOCVIEW       I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Attributes                                                  .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_DOCVIEW       I BOUND                         Passes Diagnosis for Department Stay                        .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_DOCVIEW       I CHECK                         Checks Department Stay                                      .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_DOCVIEW       I MOVEMENT_GET                  First Movement                                              .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_ITERATOR      I NEXT                          Read Next Diagnosis                                         .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_MOVEMENT      I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Movement Attributes                                         .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_MOVEMENT      I BUSINESSKEY_SET               Set LFDNR (Sequence Number)                                 .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_MOVEMENT      I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_MOVEMENT      I LFDNR_GET                     Sequence Number of the Movement                             .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_PATIENT       I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Patient Attributes                                          .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_PATIENT       I BAPI_GETDETAIL                NPAT                                                        .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_PATIENT       I BUSINESSKEY_GET               PATNR                                                       .
IF_ISH_DIAGNOSIS_PATIENT       I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I CLOSE_NODE                    Close Nodes                                                 .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I CONVERT_FOR_DISPLAY           Prepare Display Object for Display                          .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I DESTROY                       Release Display Object                                      .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I GET_DATA                      Determine Objects from Display Object                       .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Determine Field Catalog of Display Object                   .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I GET_MERGED_VALUES             Determine Rows for Merging or Sorting                       .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I GET_TYPE                      Determine Type of Object                                    .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I INITIALIZE                    Initializations                                             .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I IS_CANCELLED                  Is Object Canceled?                                         .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I LOAD                          Load Display Object                                         .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I OPEN_NODE                     Expand Node                                                 .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I REMOVE_DATA                   Remove Data from Display Object                             .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I SET_MAIN_DATA                 Read Main Data from Display Object                          .
IF_ISH_DISPLAY_OBJECT          I SET_NODE                      Set Global Open/Close Node Indicator                        .
IF_ISH_DOM                     I GET_DOM_DOCUMENT              Supplies All Object Data as DOM Document                    .
IF_ISH_DOM                     I GET_DOM_FRAGMENT              Supplies All Object Data as DOM Fragment                    .
IF_ISH_DOM                     I GET_DOM_NODE                  Supplies All Object Data as DOM Node                        .
IF_ISH_DOM                     I MODIFY_DOM_DATA               Modify Data in DOM Fragment                                 .
IF_ISH_GET_CASE                I GET_CASE                      Get Case                                                    .
IF_ISH_GET_INSTITUTION         I GET_INSTITUTION               Get Institution                                             .
IF_ISH_GET_PATIENT             I GET_PATIENT                   Get Patient (Real or with Provisional Master Data)          .
IF_ISH_IDENTIFY_OBJECT         I GET_TYPE                      Return Type of Object                                       .
IF_ISH_IDENTIFY_OBJECT         I IS_A                          Returns whether the Object Corresponds to this Type         .
IF_ISH_IDENTIFY_OBJECT         I IS_INHERITED_FROM             Returns whether the Object Corresponds to this Type         .
IF_ISH_IS_OP                   I IS_OP                         Check Whether a Surgery Is Involved                         .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I BUILD_FIELDCAT                Compile Field Catalog                                       .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I CHECK_IF_EMPTY                Check Whether Display Still Contains Data or Already Empty  .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I DESTROY                       End Display                                                 .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I DISPLAY                       Display Data                                                .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I GET_DATA                      Determin Dataset                                            .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I GET_SELECTION                 Determine Selected Data                                     .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I GET_TOOLBAR                   Determine Toolbar                                           .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I INITIALIZE                    Initializations                                             .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I INSERT_DATA                   Insert Data                                                 .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I REFRESH                       Display Updated Data                                        .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I REFRESH_DATA                  Refresh Dataset                                             .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I REMOVE_DATA                   Remove Data                                                 .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I SET_LAYOUT                    Set Layout                                                  .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I SET_SCROLL_POSITION           Set Positioning                                             .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I SET_SELECTION                 Select Data                                                 .
IF_ISH_LIST_DISPLAY            I SET_SORT_CRITERIA             Set Sort Criteria                                           .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I CALL_EDITOR                   Call Editor                                                 .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I CHANGED                       Text Was Modified in Relation to DB Status                  .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I COPY                          Copy Text                                                   .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I COPY1                         Copy Long Text From Other Source                            .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I DELETE                        Delete Long Text                                            .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I EXISTS                        Long Text Exists                                            .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I SHORTTEXT_GET                 Read Short Text                                             .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I SHORTTEXT_SET                 Set Short Text                                              .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I TEXT_GET                      Get Text                                                    .
IF_ISH_LTEXT                   I TEXT_SET                      Set Text                                                    .
IF_ISH_LTEXT_PARENT            I NAME_GET                      Name of Text Object                                         .
IF_ISH_LTEXT_PARENT            I TEXT_CHANGED                  Long Text Was Changed                                       .
IF_ISH_MASTER_DATA             I CHECK                         Check object                                                .
IF_ISH_MASTER_DATA             I SAVE                          Update Object                                               .
IF_ISH_MASTER_DATA2            I CHECK                         Check object                                                .
IF_ISH_MASTER_DATA2            I SAVE                          Update Object                                               .
IF_ISH_MD_PROOF_DATA_PROVIDER  I DATA_GET                      Read Application Data                                       .
IF_ISH_NP61_CASE_FACTORY       I CREATE                        Generates an Instance                                       .
IF_ISH_NP61_CASE_FACTORY       I DATA_SET                      Synchronize the Instance                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_CASE_FACTORY       I GET                           Get an instance                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_CASE_FACTORY       I REMOVE                        Get an Instance                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_CASE_FACTORY       I RENAME                        Get an Instance                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_DIAGNOSES_FACTORY  I CREATE                        Creates Diagnosis Instance                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_DIAGNOSES_FACTORY  I GET                           Gets Diagnosis Instance                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_DIAGNOSES_FACTORY  I REMOVE                        Delete Diagnosis Instance                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY            I ADD                           Callback for IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY_ADAPTER~prefetch_load      .
IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY            I CREATE                        Create Instance for Key                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY            I GET                           Return Instance for Key                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY            I PREFETCH                      Flag a Key for Prefetch                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_FACTORY            I REMOVE                        Delete Instance                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Are there Unsaved Objects?                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I COMMIT                        Commit Changes                                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I CONTENT_GET                   Get Attribute of an Object                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I CONTENT_SET                   Set Attribute of an Object                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I DB_STATE                      Set DB Status                                               .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I FRAMEWORK_CLOSE               Obsolete                                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I FRAMEWORK_OPEN                Obsolete                                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I HANDLE_GET                    Integer Handle for Object                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I INSTANCE_ADD                  Obsolete                                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I INSTANCE_GET                  Obsolete                                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I INSTANCE_RENAME               Obsolete                                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I MODE_GET                      Read Access Mode for Object                                 .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I MODE_SET                      Set Access Mode for Object                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I OBJECT_GET                    Object for Integer Handle                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I REGISTER                      Register Object with Framework                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I RESET                         Reset Framework                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I ROLLBACK                      Discard Changes                                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I ROOT_SET                      Move State to ROOT_TRANSACTION                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I SAVE                          Save Persistent Objects in DB                               .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I TRANSACTION_BEGIN             Start Transaction                                           .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I TRANSACTION_CHECK_CHANGES     Was Data Changed in the Current Transaction (Rollback)      .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I TRANSACTION_FINISH            Exit Transaction                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I VCODE_DIAG_GET                Read Processing Mode for Diagnosis Changes                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_FRAMEWORK          I VCODE_DIAG_SET                Set Processing Mode for Diagnosis Changes                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_CHANGE              Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_CHANGE_RNDIA        Change Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_COPY                Copy Diagnosis                                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_CREATE              Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_CREATE_RNDIA        Create Diagnosis                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGNOSIS_PRINTF              Int: Format Diagnosis Freely                                .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGPERS_GET                  Diagnosing Person                                           .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DIAGPERS_SET                  Preset Diagnosing Person                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DITXT_GET                     Catalog Text for Diagnosis                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DOCVIEW_AUTHORITY             Authorizations                                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DOCVIEW_PATIENT_GET           Diagnoses for All Cases                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DOCVIEW_REFERRAL              View for Referral Diagnoses                                 .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I DOCVIEW_TEXT_GET              Text for DocView                                            .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I FCODE_GET                     Read FCODE                                                  .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I FCODE_SET                     Set FCODE                                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I ICD_INFO_FILL                 Fill ICD10 Diagnoses                                        .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I ICD_PRIMARY_RELEASE           Delete Primary Diagnosis                                    .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I ICD_PRIMARY_SET               Set Primary Diagnosis                                       .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I OVERVIEW_GETLIST              Diagnoses for Overview Screen                               .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I RNDIA_BLANK                   RNDIA for Blank Diagnosis                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I RNDIA_FILL                    Fill RNDIA with Diagnosis                                   .
IF_ISH_NP61_MAINTAIN           I SORTINFO_GET                  Sort Information for Diagnoses                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_OBSERVER           I CHANGED                       Object Was Changed                                          .
IF_ISH_NP61_PERSISTENT         I CHECK_CHANGES                 Does Object Need to Be Saved                                .
IF_ISH_NP61_PERSISTENT         I NUMBERING                     Assign Document Numbers for Dependent Objects               .
IF_ISH_NP61_PERSISTENT         I ROLLBACK                      Object Was Rolled Back, Adjust Data                         .
IF_ISH_NP61_PERSISTENT         I SAVE                          Save Object via Update Task                                 .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I ACTIVATE                      PBO: Prepare Subscreen for Call                             .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I CURSOR_GET                    Cursor Data                                                 .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I EXIT_OKCODE                   Process Exit Command                                        .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I FOCUSED                       Cursor Is Located in Subscreen                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I OKCODE                        Set OK CODE at Start of PAI                                 .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I OKCODE_GET                    OK Code                                                     .
IF_ISH_NP61_SUBSCREEN          I STATUS_SET                    Set GUI Status                                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_TABLECONTROL       I MARKING                       Select                                                      .
IF_ISH_NP61_TABLECONTROL       I POSITION_GET                  Position in TC                                              .
IF_ISH_NP61_TABLECONTROL       I POSITION_SET                  Set Position in TC                                          .
IF_ISH_NP61_TABLECONTROL       I SCROLLING                     Scroll                                                      .
IF_ISH_NP61_UNDOABLE           I UNDO                          Object Was Reset                                            .
IF_ISH_NV2000_TOOLBAR          I CHANGE                        Change Function Bar                                         .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I ADD_CONNECTION                Build Connection Between Objects                            .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I CHECK                         Check Object                                                .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I CLEAR_LOCK                    Clear Lock on Object                                        .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I CONNECT                       Build Connection to Object (Incl. Foreign Key Maintenance)  .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I DELETE_CONNECTION             Delete Connection                                           .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I DISCONNECT                    Deactivate Connection (Including Foreign Key Maintenance)   .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_AUTHORITY_CHECK           Returns whether Authorization Check Necessary               .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_CONNECTIONS               Return Connections to Current Object                        .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_DATA_FIELD                Return One Single Data Field                                .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Return Environment Used                                     .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_FORCE_ERUP_DATA           Returns Indicator whether ER*/UP* Data Is Generated         .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I GET_TYPE                      Return Type of Object                                       .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I HIDE                          Assign an Object                                            .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I IS_ACTUAL                     Check if Object Is Current. (Compare with DB Status)        .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I IS_COMPLETE                   Is the Object Complete for Update?                          .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I IS_HIDDEN                     Is the Object Hidden?                                       .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I REMOVE_CONNECTION             Deactivate Connection                                       .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I SAVE                          Update Object                                               .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I SET_AUTHORITY_CHECK           Set if Authorization Check to Be Run                        .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I SET_FORCE_ERUP_DATA           Sets Indicator whether ER*/UP* Data Is Generated            .
IF_ISH_OBJECTBASE              I SET_LOCK                      Set Lock to Prevent Changes to Object                       .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I CHECK                         Check Input Data                                            .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I CHECK_CHANGES                 Returns Whether Changes Can Be Made                         .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I EXIT_COMMAND                  Processing of an Exit Function Code                         .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I TRANSPORT_FROM_SCREEN         Data Transport at PAI                                       .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I TRANSPORT_TO_SCREEN           Data Transport at PBO                                       .
IF_ISH_POPUP_CALLBACK          I USER_COMMAND                  Processing of a Function Code                               .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I AFTER_PAI                     Processing after PAI of Dialog Box                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I AFTER_PBO                     Processing after PBO of Dialog Box                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I BEFORE_PAI_SUBSCREEN          Processing before PAI of Subscreen                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I BEFORE_PBO_SUBSCREEN          Processing before PBO of Subscreen                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I CHECK                         Execute Checks                                              .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I CHECK_CHANGES                 Returns whether Changes Were Made                           .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I COLLECT_MESSAGES              Collect Messages                                            .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I DESTROY                       Destroy Process                                             .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I EXIT_COMMAND                  Execute Exit Command of Dialog Box                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_CALLBACK                  Returns the Callback Object                                 .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_CHECK_CHANGES_ON_CANCEL   Returns whether Check for Changes at Termination            .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_CHECK_ON_CHOICE           Returns whether Check at Selection                          .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration of the Process                    .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_EXIT_ON_WARNINGS          Returns whether Exit when Warnings Issued                   .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_POPUP_POSITION            Returns the Position Data of the Dialog Box                 .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_POPUP_TITLE               Returns the Title of the Dialog Box                         .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_SCREEN                    Returns the Screen of the Dialog Box                        .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I GET_VCODE                     Returns the Processing Mode of the Dialog Box               .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of the Process                               .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I PAI                           Execute PAI of the Dialog Box                               .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I PBO                           Execute PBO of the Dialog Box                               .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I RUN                           Launch the Dialog Box                                       .
IF_ISH_PRC_POPUP               I USER_COMMAND                  Execute User Command of the Dialog Box                      .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I CALL_OK_CODE                  Execute OK Code                                             .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I CHECK                         Execute Checks                                              .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check if Changes Have Occurred                              .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I INITIALIZE                    Perform initialization                                      .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_ISH_PROCESS                 I SET_CURSOR                    Position cursor                                             .
IF_ISH_REDOMA                  I CHECK                         Check Customer-Specific Data                                .
IF_ISH_REDOMA                  I MODIFY                        Processing of Customer-Specific Data                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I BEFORE_CALL_SUBSCREEN         Processing Before CALL SUBSCREEN                            .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I BEFORE_PBO                    This method is called before PBO of screen takes place      .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CHECK                         Runs Checks                                                 .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CHECK_CHANGES                 Check if Screen Field Values Have Been Changed              .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CLEAR_CURSORFIELD             Deletes the Cursor Position                                 .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CLEAR_EV_USER_COMMEND_RESULT  Clears the User Command                                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CREATE_ALL_LISTBOXES          Create All List Boxes of a Screen                           .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I CREATE_LISTBOX                Create and Fill List Box                                    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I DELETE_EMPTY_LINES            GRID (or Table Control): Delete Empty Rows from the Grid    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I DESTROY                       Destroy Instance                                            .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP           Determine Active Tab Page of the Screen                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_CALLER                    Returns the Calling Program                                 .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_CONFIG                    Returns the Configuration Object                            .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_CURSORFIELD               Returns the Current Cursor Position                         .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_DATA                      Transfer Data from the Screen                               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_DEFAULT_CURSORFIELD       Returns the Field Name for Standard Cursor Position         .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_DEF_CRS_POSSIBLE          Determination of Possible Default Cursor Positions          .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_DYNPRO_HEADER             Returns Header Data for Screen                              .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_DYNPRO_HEADER_COLUMNS     Returns Maintained Column Number for Screen                 .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Returns the Environment                                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDS                    Determine All Screen Fields and their Values                .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDS_CHANGEABLE         Determine Changeable Screen Fields and their Values         .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDS_DEFINITION         Determine Properties of the Screen Fields                   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDS_VALUE              Determine All Screen Fields (Tech. Properties and Values)   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDVAL_FV               Returns a FieldValue Field Value                            .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDVAL_IDENTIFY         Returns an Object Field Value                               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDVAL_SCREEN           Returns a Screen Field Value                                .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELDVAL_SINGLE           Returns a Single Field Value                                .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_FVATTR_DISABLED           Returns the DISABLED Attribute of Field Value (only ALVGrid).
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_HANDLE_MANDATORY_FIELDS   Returns Flag whether Rqrd-Entry Fields of Screen Are Handled.
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_LOCK                      Returns the Lock Object                                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Retursn the Main Object                                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_PARENT                    Return Container (Parent) of the Screen                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_SCRMOD_BY_FIELDNAME       Determination Screen Modification for a Field               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_T_SCRMOD                  Determination of Screen Table with Div. Modification        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_T_SCRM_FIELD              Returns All Screen Fields for Screen Modification           .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_USE_TNDYM_CURSOR          Determination of Cursor Positioning Acc. to Screen Modific. .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I GET_VCODE                     Returns a Processing Mode                                   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I HELP_REQUEST                  F1 Help (Documentation)                                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Global Attributes                         .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I IS_FIELD_CHANGED              A Specific Field Was Changed Last (ON/OFF)                  .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I IS_FIELD_INITIAL              Is a Specific Field Initial (ON/OFF)                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I MODIFY_SCREEN                 Change Appearance of the Screen Fields                      .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I OK_CODE_SCREEN                Transfer OK Code and Possibly Execute Screen Function       .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I PROCESS_AFTER_INPUT           PAI Event Processing                                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I PROCESS_BEFORE_OUTPUT         PBO Event Processing                                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I RAISE_EV_ERROR                Trigger Event "Screen Processing Error Occurred"            .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I RAISE_EV_USER_COMMAND         Trigger Event "User Command in Screen"                      .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I REMIND_CURSORFIELD            Memorizes the Current Cursor Position                       .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP           Set Tab Page of Screen as "Active"                          .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_CALLER                    Sets the Calling Program                                    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_CONFIG                    Sets the Configuration Object                               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_CURSOR                    Position Cursor on a Field in the Screen                    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_CURSORFIELD               Sets the Cursor Position                                    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_DATA                      Transfer of the Data to the Screen                          .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_DATA_FROM_FIELDVAL        Transfer Values of the Field Values into the Data Objects   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_ENVIRONMENT               Sets the Environment                                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_EV_USER_COMMAND_RESULT    Returns whether the User Command Was Executed               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDS                    Transfer Changes and Presettings of Screen Fields           .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDS_OLD                Set "Old" Status of the Screen Fields                       .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDVAL_FROM_DATA        Fill Field Values from the Data Objects                     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDVAL_FV               Sets a FieldValue Field Value                               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDVAL_IDENTIFY         Sets an Object Field Value                                  .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDVAL_SCREEN           Sets a Screen Field Value                                   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIELDVAL_SINGLE           Sets a Single Field Value                                   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FIRST_TIME                Set Attribute that PBO Will Run First                       .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_FVATTR_DISABLED           Sets the DISABLED Attribute of a Field Value (only ALVGrid) .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_HANDLE_MANDATORY_FIELDS   Sets Flag Whether Rqrd-Entry Fields on Screen Are Handled   .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_INSTANCE_FOR_DISPLAY      Transfer Screen Instance                                    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_LOCK                      Sets the Lock Object                                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_MAIN_OBJECT               Sets the Main Object                                        .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_PARENT                    Set Container (Parent) for the Screen                       .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I SET_USE_TNDYM_CURSOR          Cursor Positioning According to Screen Modification         .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I TRANSPORT_FROM_DY             Transfer Values from the Screen Fields into the Instance    .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I TRANSPORT_TO_DY               Transfer Values into the Actual Screen Fields               .
IF_ISH_SCREEN                  I VALUE_REQUEST                 Input Help                                                  .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_COLLAPSIBLE      I GET_EMBEDDED_SCREENS          Returns All Embedded Screen Objects (Active + Inactive)     .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_COLLAPSIBLE      I GET_SCREEN_ACTIVE             Returns the Currently Active Screen Object                  .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_COLLAPSIBLE      I GET_SCR_COLLAPSIBLE           Returns the Collapsible Screen                              .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_COLLAPSIBLE      I SWITCH                        Display Alternative Screen                                  .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_STD              I SET_DATA_ADDITIONAL           Set Specific Fields in the Screen                           .
IF_ISH_SCREEN_STD              I SET_DYNPRO                    Call Up Another Screen From Main Dialog                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I APPEND_ROW                    Adds a Row                                                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I BUILD_UCOMM_ROW_COL           Creates a User Command with Row- and Column Info            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I DELECT_ROW                    Deselects a Row                                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I DELECT_ROWS                   Deselects Multiple Rows                                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I DISABLE_CELL                  Switches a Cell to "Not Ready-for-Input"                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I DISABLE_ROW                   Switches a Row to "Not Ready-for-Input"                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I ENABLE_CELL                   Switches a Cell to "Ready-for-Input"                        .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I ENABLE_ROW                    Switches a Row to "Ready-for-Input"                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ALLOW_NEW_ROWS            Returns Whether New Rows Are Permitted                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ALV_GRID                  Returns the Related ALV Grid                                .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_CELL_FIELDVAL             Returns a Cell FieldValue                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_COLUMN_FIELDVALS          Returns the Column FieldValues for a Row                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_CONFIG_ALV_GRID           Returns the ALV Grid Configuration Object                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_CURRENT_CELL_FIELDVAL     Returns the Current Cell FieldValue                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_FIELDCAT                  Returns the Field Catalog                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_FILTER                    Returns the Filter Criteria                                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_LAYOUT                    Returns the Layout                                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_REMIND_SELECTED_ROWS      Returns Indicator that Selection(s) Are Kept                .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ROW_FIELDVAL              Returns a Row Field Value                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ROW_FIELDVALS             Returns the Desired Row FieldValues                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ROW_FIELDVAL_OBJECT       Returns a Row FieldValue Object                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_ROW_FIELDVAL_OBJECTS      Returns the Desired Row FieldValue Objects                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_SELECTED_ROW_FIELDVAL     Returns the Selected Row FieldValue                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_SELECTED_ROW_FIELDVALS    Returns Selected Row Field Values                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_SORT                      Returns the Sort Criteria                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_TOOLBAR_FUNCTIONS         Returns the Current Toolbar Functions                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_TOOLBAR_FVAR              Returns the Current Toolbar Function Variant                .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_UCOMM_COL                 Returns the Column Name for a User Command                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_UCOMM_ROW                 Retunrs the Row Name for a User Command                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I GET_VARIANT                   Returns the Current Variant of the ALV Grid                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I IS_CELL_ENABLED               Returns Whether Specified Cell Is Ready-for-Input           .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I IS_ROW_ENABLED                Returns Whether Specified Row Is Ready-for-Input            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I REMOVE_ROW                    Removes a Row                                               .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SELECT_ROW                    Selects a Row                                               .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SELECT_ROWS                   Selects Multiple Rows                                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_ALLOW_NEW_ROWS            Sets Indicator Whether New Rows Are Permitted               .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_CELL_FIELDVAL             Sets a Cell FieldValue                                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_COLUMN_FIELDVALS          Sets the Column FieldValues for a Row                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_DEFAULT_CURSOR            Sets the Cursor on the Default Cell                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_FILTER                    Sets the Filter Criteria                                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_LAYOUT                    Sets the Layout                                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_REMIND_SELECTED_ROWS      Sets Indicator that Selection(s) Are Kept                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_SORT                      Sets the Sort Criteria                                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_TOOLBAR_FUNCTIONS         Sets the Toolbar Functions                                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_TOOLBAR_FVAR              Sets the Toolbar Function Variant                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_GRID            I SET_VARIANT                   Sets the Variant of the ALV Grid                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I BUILD_UCOMM_ROW               Forms User Command with Row Info                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I BUILD_UCOMM_ROW_COL           Forms User Command with Row and Column Info                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I DESELECT_ITEMS                Deselect Entries                                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_ALLOW_MULTIPLE_CBX        Returns Whether Mult. Selection Using Checkbox Is Permitted .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_ALV_TREE                  Returns Underlying ALV Tree                                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_CHECKED_ROW_FIELDVALS     Returns Checked Row Field Values                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_CONFIG_ALV_TREE           Returns ALV Tree Configuration Object                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_ROW_FIELDVAL              Returns a Row Field Value                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_SELECTED_ROW_FIELDVALS    Returns Selected Row Field Values                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_UCOMM_COL                 Returns Column Info from a User Command                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I GET_UCOMM_ROW                 Returns Row Info from a User Command                        .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I IS_TOOLBAR_APPL_EVENT         Returns Whether Toolbar Event Is an Application Event       .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I IS_TREE_APPL_EVENT            Returns Whether Tree Event Is an Application Event          .
IF_ISH_SCR_ALV_TREE            I SET_ALLOW_MULTIPLE_CBX        Sets Whether Mult. Selection Using Checkbox Is Permitted    .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I BUILD_UCOMM                   Create User Command                                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I DESTROY_INCL_EMBCNTL          Destroy Instance Including Embedded Control Screens         .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns the Related GUI Container                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I GET_ORIGINAL_UCOMM            Returns the Original User Command                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I IS_DRAGDROP_SUPPORTED         Returns Whether Drag&Drop Is Supported                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I IS_SYSEV_UCOMM                Is Transferred User Command a System Event User Command?    .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I IS_UCOMM_SUPPORTED            Returns Whether User Command Is Supported                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I PAI_INCL_EMBCNTL              PAI Process Including Embedded Control Screens              .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I PBO_INCL_EMBCNTL              PBO Processing Including Embedded Control Screens           .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I RAISE_EV_SYSTEM_EVENT         Triggers the Event EV_SYSTEM_EVENT                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I SET_EV_SYSTEM_EVENT_RESULT    Sets the Result after Event EV_SYSTEM_EVENT                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I SET_OKCODE_SYSEV              Triggers a System Event OK_CODE                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I SET_OKCODE_SYSEV_ERROR        Triggers the OK_CODE SYSEV_ERROR                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_CONTROL             I SUPPORT_DRAGDROP              Sets Whether Drag&Drop Should Be Supported                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_HTML                I BUILD_UCOMM_LINK_CLICKED      Creates User Command Click of a Link in Dynamic Document    .
IF_ISH_SCR_HTML                I GET_CONFIG_HTML               Returns the HTML Configuration Object                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_HTML                I GET_DD_DOCUMENT               Returns the Related Dynamic Document Object                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_HTML                I GET_UCOMM_KEYSTRING           Returns the Key String for the Dynamic Document Link        .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I BUILD_CELL_FROM_FIELDNAME     Returns the Cell for the Specified FieldValue Field Name    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I BUILD_FIELDNAME_FROM_CELL     Returns the FieldValue Field Name for the Specified Cell    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ALIAS_NAME                Returns the Alias Name                                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_BORDER                    Returns the Frame Property                                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_CELL_CONTAINER            Returns the GUI Container for the Specified Cell            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_CELL_FIELDVAL             Returns the FieldValue for the Specified Cell               .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_CELL_SCREEN               Returns the Screen Object for the Specified Cell            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_MODE               Returns the Column Mode                                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_PROPERTIES         Returns the Properties of a Column                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_SASH_MOVABLE       Returns the Movability of the Column Separator              .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_SASH_VISIBLE       Returns the Visibility of the Column Separator              .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_VISIBLE            Returns the Visibility of the Specified Column              .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COLUMN_WIDTH              Returns the Column Width                                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_COMMON_PROPERTIES         Returns General Properties of the Splitter                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_CONFIG_SPLITTER           Returns the Releated Splitter Configuration Object          .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_BORDER                Returns the Default Frame Property                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_MODE           Returns the Default Column Mode                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_PROPERTIES     Returns the Default Properties of a Column                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_SASH_MOVABLE   Returns the Default Movability of the Column Separator      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_SASH_VISIBLE   Returns the Default Visibility of the Column Separator      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_VISIBLE        Returns the Default Visibility of the Specified Column      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COLUMN_WIDTH          Returns the Default Column Width                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_COMMON_PROPERTIES     Returns the Default General Properties                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_HEIGHT            Returns the Default Row Height                              .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_MODE              Returns the Default Row Mode                                .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_PROPERTIES        Returns the Default General Properties of a Row             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_SASH_MOVABLE      Returns the Default Movability of the Row Separator         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_SASH_VISIBLE      Returns the Default Visibility of the Row Separator         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_DEF_ROW_VISIBLE           Returns the Default Visibility of the Specified Row         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_EMBEDDED_CONTROLS         Returns the Embedded Control Screen                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_NR_OF_COLUMNS             Returns the Number of Columns                               .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_NR_OF_ROWS                Returns the Number of Rows                                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_READ_PROPERTIES           Returns "Import User-Specific Properties" Indicator         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_HEIGHT                Returns the Row Hight                                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_MODE                  Returns the Row Mode                                        .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_PROPERTIES            Returns the Properties of a Row                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_SASH_MOVABLE          Returns the Movability of the Row Separator                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_SASH_VISIBLE          Returns the Visibility of the Row Separator                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_ROW_VISIBLE               Returns the Visibility of the Specified Row                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_SAVE_PROPERTIES           Returns "Save User-Specific Properties" Indicator           .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I GET_SPLITTER_CONTAINER        Returns the Related GUI Splitter Container                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I IS_CELL_VISIBLE               Returns Whether a Cell Is Visible                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I READ_COLUMN_PROPERTIES        Reads User-Specific Properties of a Column                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I READ_COMMON_PROPERTIES        Reads User-Specific General Properties                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I READ_PROPERTIES               Reads All User-Specific Properties                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I READ_ROW_PROPERTIES           Reads User-Specific Properties of a Row                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SAVE_COLUMN_PROPERTIES        Saves User-Specific Properties of a Column                  .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SAVE_COMMON_PROPERTIES        Saves User-Specific General Properties                      .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SAVE_PROPERTIES               Saves All User-Specific Properties                          .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SAVE_ROW_PROPERTIES           Saves User-Specific Properties of a Row                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ALIAS_NAME                Sets the Alias Name                                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_BORDER                    Sets the Frame Properties                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_CELL_SCREEN               Places the Screen Object in the Specified Cell              .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_MODE               Sets Column Mode                                            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_PROPERTIES         Sets the Properties of a Column                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_SASH_MOVABLE       Sets the Movability of the Column Separator                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_SASH_VISIBLE       Sets the Visibility of the Column Separator                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_VISIBLE            Sets the Visibility of the Specified Column                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COLUMN_WIDTH              Sets the Column Width                                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_COMMON_PROPERTIES         Sets General Properties                                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_BORDER                Sets the Default Frame Property                             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_MODE           Sets the Default Column Mode                                .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_PROPERTIES     Sets the Default Properties of a Column                     .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_SASH_MOVABLE   Sets the Default Movability of the Column Separator         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_SASH_VISIBLE   Sets the Default Visibility of the Column Separator         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_VISIBLE        Sets the Default Visibility of the Specified Column         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COLUMN_WIDTH          Sets the Default Column Width                               .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_COMMON_PROPERTIES     Sets the Default General Properties                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_HEIGHT            Sets the Default Row Height                                 .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_MODE              Sets the Default Row Mode                                   .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_PROPERTIES        Sets the Default Properties of a Row                        .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_SASH_MOVABLE      Sets the Default Movability of the Row Separator            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_SASH_VISIBLE      Sets the Default Visibility of the Row Separator            .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_DEF_ROW_VISIBLE           Sets the Default Visiblity of the Specified Row             .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_READ_PROPERTIES           Set the "Import Properties" Indicator                       .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_HEIGHT                Sets the Row Height                                         .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_MODE                  Sets the Row Mode                                           .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_PROPERTIES            Sets the Properties of a Row                                .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_SASH_MOVABLE          Sets the Movability of the Row Separator                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_SASH_VISIBLE          Sets the Visibility of the Row Separator                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_ROW_VISIBLE               Sets the Visibility of the Specified Row                    .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SET_SAVE_PROPERTIES           Sets the "Save Properties" Indicator                        .
IF_ISH_SCR_SPLITTER            I SPLIT_CELL                    Creates a Splitter Simple Screen in the Specified Cell      .
IF_ISH_SNAPSHOT_CALLBACK       I CREATE_SNAPSHOT_OBJECT        Creates a Snapshot Object with the Current Status           .
IF_ISH_SNAPSHOT_CALLBACK       I UNDO_SNAPSHOT_OBJECT          Reset Data to a Previous Status                             .
IF_ISH_SNAPSHOT_OBJECT         I SNAPSHOT                      Object Content Being Held Temporarily (also See UNDO)       .
IF_ISH_SNAPSHOT_OBJECT         I UNDO                          Reactivate Content of Object Held with SNAPSHOT             .
IF_ISH_SSF_OTF                 I OTF_GET                       OTF Data                                                    .
IF_ISH_SSF_SIGNATURE           I CREATE_FROM_DATA              Instantiate Signature                                       .
IF_ISH_SSF_SIGNATURE           I DATA_GET                      Data for Signing                                            .
IF_ISH_SSF_SIGNATURE           I TYPE_GET                      Type of Signed Data                                         .
IF_ISH_SSF_SIGNATURE           I VERIFY                        Verify                                                      .
IF_ISH_USE_TEXTMODULE          I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change SAPscript Text                                       .
IF_ISH_USE_TEXTMODULE          I CREATE_TEXTMODULE_ON_USE      Create Text Module when Used                                .
IF_ISH_USE_TEXTMODULE          I EDIT_TEXT                     Call SAPscript Text Editor                                  .
IF_ISH_USE_TEXTMODULE          I GET_TEXT                      Return SAPscript Text                                       .
IF_ISH_USE_TEXTMODULE          I GET_TEXT_HEADER               Determine SAPscript Text Header                             .
IF_ISH_UTL_ITERATOR            I HAS_NEXT                      Returns TRUE if Further Elements Exist                      .
IF_ISH_UTL_ITERATOR            I NEXT                          Returns the Next Element                                    .
IF_ISH_UTL_ITERATOR            I REMOVE                        Deletes the Last Element Returned by Iterator from the Coll..
IF_ISJP_ITEM                   I ACC_INTERF_BEFORE_SAVE        Set attributes of invoice summary items                     .
IF_ISJP_ITEM                   I DOWN_PAYM_REQUEST             Set additional attributes of down payment request           .
IF_ISJP_ITEM                   I MANUAL_POSTING                Set attributes of new manually entered invoices             .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I ACTIVATE_AUTHORISATION_BUTTONSActivate Buttons                                            .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I BUNDLE_BDS                    Billing Data Bundling for Authorization                     .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I DEACTIVATE_AUTHORISATION_FIELDDeactivate Authorization Fields                             .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I DELETE_AUTHORISATION          Delete Authorizations                                       .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I DISPLAY_BDS_AUTHORISATION     Display Billing Dataset Authorizations                      .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I DISPLAY_ITEM_AUTHORISATION    Display Item Authorizations                                 .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I POPULATE_AUTHORISATION_FIELDS Make Authorization Fields Available                         .
IF_ISM_AM_AUTH_BUNDELING       I UNBUNDLE_BDS                  Unbundle Billing Datasets for Authorization                 .
IF_ISM_AM_COPY_PRICING         I EXPORT_PRICING_TABLE          Export Condition Table                                      .
IF_ISM_AM_COPY_PRICING         I REBUILD_PRICING_TABLE         Create New Condition Table                                  .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I ACTIVATE_ONLINE_CALE_BUTTONS  Activate Buttons                                            .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I CALENDER_DISPLAY_MODE         Display Calendar                                            .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I CLEAR_ONLINE_CALENDER         Delete Online Calendar                                      .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I MODIFY_FIELD_ATTRIBUTE        Change Field Attributes                                     .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I ONLINE_PRICING                Copy Number of Days for Pricing                             .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I SET_DATES_IN_CALE             Select Date in Calendar                                     .
IF_ISM_AM_ONLINE_CALENDER      I SHOW_CALENDAR                 Display Online Calendar                                     .
IF_ISM_AREA_RULE               I GET_REFISSUES                 Determines Reference Issues                                 .
IF_ISM_CIC_FRAME_BPSEARCH      I GET_OKCODES                   Get OK Codes                                                .
IF_ISM_CIC_FRAME_BPSEARCH      I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Get Search Subscreen                                        .
IF_ISM_CIC_FRAME_BPSEARCH      I HANDLE_OKCODE                 Process OK Code                                             .
IF_ISM_CIC_FRAME_BPSEARCH      I SET_APPLICATIONS              Set Applications                                            .
IF_ISM_CIC_FRAME_BPSEARCH      I SET_CALLDATA                  Set Call Data                                               .
IF_ISM_CIC_ORDER_DETAIL        I GET_SCREEN                    Return Screen                                               .
IF_ISM_CIC_ORDER_DETAIL        I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_ISM_CIC_ORDER_DETAIL        I REFRESH                       Refresh Display                                             .
IF_ISM_CIC_ORDER_DETAIL        I SET_VISIBLE                   Set Display                                                 .
IF_ISM_CONTRACTLIST_MODEL      I GET_NODES                     Get Nodes (Contracts)                                       .
IF_ISM_CONTRACTTREE            I GET_NODES                     Get Nodes (Contracts)                                       .
IF_ISM_DEMANDBLOCK             I CHANGE_BLOCKED                Change Quantity Plan Status                                 .
IF_ISM_DM_DOCUMENT_WHERE_USED  I DISPLAY_OBJECTS_OF_IO         Display Users of a Document                                 .
IF_ISM_EVENTVERIFY_EVENTFIELDS I GET_EVENT_VERIFY_FIELDS       Read Customer Fields for GRID 'Event'                       .
IF_ISM_EVENTVERIFY_QUAN_FIELDS I GET_QUAN_VERIFY_FIELDS        Supply Customer Fields with Data for Display                .
IF_ISM_EVENTVERIFY_SET_ALERT   I SET_ALERT_ICON                Set Icon for Exceeding, Undershooting Sales Quantities      .
IF_ISM_INSERT_OBSERVABLE       I HANDLE_INSERT_SELECTED        Insert Selected                                             .
IF_ISM_OP_ADD_DATA_SOURCE      I ADJUST_OBJECT_KEY             Correct Object Key                                          .
IF_ISM_OP_ADD_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_ADDITIONAL_ELEMENTS       Retrieve Additional Container Elements                      .
IF_ISM_OP_ADD_DATA_SOURCE      I GET_ELEMENT_VALUE             Retrieve Value for Additional Container Element             .
IF_ISM_SALES_ORDER_IMPORT      I EDIT                          Edit Record                                                 .
IF_ISM_SALES_ORDER_IMPORT      I GET_ICON                      Icon for Record Type                                        .
IF_ISM_SALES_ORDER_IMPORT      I PREPARE_RECORD_FOR_DISPLAY    Format Record                                               .
IF_ISM_SALES_ORDER_IMPORT      I PROCESS                       Process Record                                              .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I ADD_CONTRACT                  Add Contract (Add Dynamically to Hierarchy)                 .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I ADD_CONTRACTLIST              Add Contracts                                               .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I ADD_FILTER_OBJECT             Add New Filter Value                                        .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I BUILD_HIERACHY                Build Hierarchy for Display                                 .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I INTERNAL_HIERACHIE_CHECK      Internal Check on Consistency of Hierarchy                  .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I RESET_DISPLAY                 Reset Display Attributes                                    .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I SET_CONTRACTLIST              Administration Class Assigned for Contracts                 .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I SET_QUANTITYSERVER            Define Server for Quantities for Contract                   .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I SET_VIEWER                    Assign Viewer Control                                       .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I UPDATE_CONTRACTLIST           Contracts: Refresh Mix                                      .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTINSERTTREE   I UPDATE_NODE_ATTRIBUTS         Refresh Node Attributes                                     .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTTREE         I GET_DELETED_NODE              Display Deleted Assignments                                 .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTTREE         I GET_NODES                     Display all Node Assignments for Regenerative Planning      .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTTREE         I ITEMTABLE_CONTRACT_BUILD      Set Up Item Table for Viewer (Reload Data)                  .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTTREE         I MAPKEY2NODEKEY                Map Key for Contracts/Items -" Internal                     .
IF_ISM_SD_CONTRACTTREE         I MAPNODEKEY2KEY                Map Internal Key -" Contract/Item                           .
IF_ISM_SD_LISTORDERCHANGE      I GET_MODE                      Get Mode (Display/Change)                                   .
IF_ISM_SD_LISTORDERCHANGE      I GET_ORDERS                    Read Orders                                                 .
IF_ISM_SD_LISTORDERCHANGE      I SAVE                          Save Changed Orders                                         .
IF_ISM_SD_LISTORDERCHANGE      I SET_MODE                      Set Mode (Display/Change)                                   .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I ADD_RANGE_LINE                Extend Range Table                                          .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CLEAR                         Clear All Range Tables and Parameters                       .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CLEAR_PARAMETER               Clear Parameters                                            .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CLEAR_RANGE_TAB               Clear Individual or All Range Tables                        .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CONVERT_FROM_PARAMS           Convert Parameter Table to Range Tables                     .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CONVERT_RANGE_TAB             Convert Value Table to Range Table                          .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I CONVERT_TO_PARAMS             Convert Range Tables to Parameter Table                     .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I SELECT                        Select objects                                              .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I SELECT_FROM_PARAMS            Select Objects (Parameter Table)                            .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I SET_PARAMETER                 Set Parameters                                              .
IF_ISM_SD_OBJECT_SET           I SET_RANGE_TAB                 Set Range Table                                             .
IF_ISM_SD_ORDER_LOCK           I IS_LOCKED                     Check Whether Object is Locked                              .
IF_ISM_SD_QUANTITYCONTROLABLE  I RECALCULATE                   Recalculate Quantities for Objects                          .
IF_ISM_SD_TB_EVENT_VERIFY      I CALCULATE                     Calculate Sales Figures                                     .
IF_ISM_SD_TB_ORDERBOOK         I EXECUTE                       Execute method                                              .
IF_ISM_SD_TREEAPPLOGABLE       I SET_CONTEXT                   Set Application Log Context                                 .
IF_ISM_SD_TREEAPPLOGABLE       I SET_PROFILE                   Application Log: Set Format Profile                         .
IF_ISM_SD_VIEWERORDERCHANGE    I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check for Entries Made                                      .
IF_ISM_SD_VIEWERORDERCHANGE    I EXECUTE_REFRESH               Execute Refresh                                             .
IF_ISM_SD_VIEWERORDERCHANGE    I GET_MODE                      Get Display/Change Mode                                     .
IF_ISM_SD_VIEWERORDERCHANGE    I REGISTER_REFRESH              Flag Refresh                                                .
IF_ISM_SD_VIEWERORDERCHANGE    I SET_MODE                      Set Display/Change Mode                                     .
IF_ISM_SE_PARALLEL_RFC         I CALL_RFC_FUNCTION             Call Function Module by RFC                                 .
IF_ISM_SE_PARALLEL_RFC2        I CALL_RFC_FUNCTION             Call Function Module by RFC                                 .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUS1006       I CPOINTER_UPDATE               Generate Change Pointer                                     .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUS1006       I IS_ACTIVE                     SE Active for Object                                        .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUS1006       I SEARCH                        Find                                                        .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM031     I CPOINTER_UPDATE               Generate Change Pointer                                     .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM031     I IS_ACTIVE                     SE Active for Object                                        .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM031     I SEARCH                        Find                                                        .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM032     I CPOINTER_UPDATE               Generate Change Pointer                                     .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM032     I IS_ACTIVE                     SE Active for Object                                        .
IF_ISM_SE_SEARCH_BUSISM032     I SEARCH                        Find                                                        .
IF_ISM_WBZ_ANREDE              I ADJUST_TITLE_TO_BPTYPE        Adjust Form of Address to Bus. Partner Category             .
IF_ISM_WBZ_ANREDE              I CONVERT_TO_EXTERNAL           Convert Form of Address Before Det. WBZ Form of Address     .
IF_ISM_WORKLIST_CHECKS         I CHECK_WORKLIST                Checks on Changed Segments (MARA, MARC, MVKE)               .
IF_ISR_APPL_HANDLER            I ADDITIONAL_CHARAS_DIALOG      Call Additional Dialog for Characteristics                  .
IF_ISR_APPL_HANDLER            I GET_PROPERTIES                Return Application-Specific Attributes                      .
IF_ISR_APPL_RUNTIME_HANDLER    I OBJECT_TYPE_CHECK             Checks which object type is used                            .
IF_ISR_LPD_PROVIDER            I GETPARAMETERS                 Parameter for ISR Call                                      .
IF_ISR_LPD_PROVIDER            I GETSYSTEMALIAS                System Alias                                                .
IF_ISR_WIZARD                  I ACTIVATE                      Application-Specific Activation                             .
IF_ISU_BI_BICO_ACTIONS         I CUST_ACTION_AFTER_REBILL      Customer Actions After Rebilling                            .
IF_ISU_BI_BICO_ACTIONS         I CUST_ACTION_BEFORE_EXIT       Customer Actions Before Exiting Bill Correction             .
IF_ISU_BI_BICO_ACTIONS         I CUST_ACTION_BEFORE_EXIT_REMOTECustomer Actions Before Exiting Bill Correction (IC WC)     .
IF_ISU_BI_BICO_ACTIONS         I CUST_ACTION_BEFORE_REV        Customer Actions Before Invoicing Reversal                  .
IF_ISU_BI_EBF_HEADER           I ALLOW                         Permissibility of IS-U Old Documents                        .
IF_ISU_BI_EBF_LINE             I NEW                           Insert New Document Lines (Do Not Use, Internal Only)       .
IF_ISU_BI_EBF_LINE             I PREASSIGN                     Preselect Lines for Correction                              .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I CLOSE                         Exit Profile Processing                                     .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I CREATE                        Create EDM Profile Header                                   .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I CREATE_VALUE_VERSION          Create Version for Current Values                           .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I GENERATE_REPLACEMENT_VALUES   Create Replacement Values/Extrapolation Values              .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I GET_ACT_VALID_VALUE_TIMERANGESPeriods During Which Valid Profile Values Are Available     .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I GET_VALID_VALUE_TIMERANGES    Read Validity Period for Profile values                     .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I LINK_DB_PROFILE               Allocate Database Profile to Temporary Profile              .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I OPEN_PROFILE                  Open EDM Profile                                            .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I PERFORM_VALUES_ACTION         Execute Action on Profile Value (Status Change)             .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I READ_DATA                     Read Profile Values                                         .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I UPDATE                        Write Profile Data to Database                              .
IF_ISU_EDM_TMP_PROFILE_METHODS I UPDATE_PREPARE                Prepare Update                                              .
IF_ISU_PROD_ATTRIBUTE          I F4_KEY_REFERENCE              Search Help for Key Reference                               .
IF_ISU_PROD_ATTRIBUTE          I GET_PROPERTIES                Supplies Attribute Characteristics                          .
IF_ISU_PROD_ATTRIBUTE          I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets Modifiable Attribute Characteristics                   .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I DELETE                        Delete Subtree(s)                                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I DUPLICATE                     Duplicate Subtree                                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Gets the Attributes                                         .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_PRODUCT_FUNCTIONS         Supplies Possible Functions in the Node                     .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_PRODUCT_PARTS             Supplies Partial Products                                   .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_PROPERTIES                Supplies Product Characteristics                            .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_SUB_PRODUCTS              Supplies Subproducts                                        .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I GET_TOP_NODE_PROPERTIES       Delivers the Properties of the TOP Node                     .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I PRODUCT_PART_ADD              Adds a Partial Product                                      .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I PRODUCT_PART_REMOVE           Deletes a Partial Product                                   .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I SET_CRM_PRICE_PARAM           Sets Parameter Value for CRM Price Node                     .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets the Modifiable Product Characteristics                 .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I SUB_PRODUCT_REMOVE            Remove Subproduct                                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I SUB_PRODUCT_REPLACE           Replace Subproduct                                          .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_CUST          I SUB_PRODUCT_SET               Set Subproduct                                              .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I ADD_NODE_TO_DONE_LIST         Adds a Node to the List of Processed Nodes                  .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I CHECK_OPTIONAL_NODE_ACTIVE    Indicates Whether Node Must be Processed                    .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ALIASNAME                 Supplies the Alias Name of a Node Category                  .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the Parameters                                      .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEF             Provides Definition of an Attribute                         .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_LIST            Supplies the List of all Attributes for the Node            .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_LIST_EXT        Supplies Enhanced List of all Attributes for the Node       .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Supplies the Value of an Attribute                          .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_DESCRIPTION               Supplies Text for the Node                                  .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_DONE_LIST                 Supplies the List of Previously Processed Nodes             .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_EDITABLE_PARAMS           Supplies List of the Parameters Still to Be Edited          .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_FATHER_NODE               Supplies a Reference to Predecessor Nodes                   .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_IDENT_ATTRIBUTE_LIST      Supplies the List of all Identifying Attributes             .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_KEY_ATTRIBUTE_LIST        Supplies the List of all Key Attributes                     .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_NODE                      Supplies the Internal Node ID                               .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_NODE_CONST_ID_LIST        Supplier a List of Identifying Constants                    .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_NODE_PARAM_LIST           Supplies a List of Parameters for the Current Node          .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_OPTIONAL_FLAG             Indicates Whether Node Is Optional                          .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_PATTERN_VALUE             Provides Reference Value from the Container                 .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_PRODUCT                   Supplies the Name of the Product for the Current Node       .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_PROD_ID                   Supplies the ID of the Master Data Template                 .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_SCRIPT                    Supplies the Program for Processing the Node                .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_SUB_PRODUCTS              Supplies Subnodes                                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_TOP_NODE_HEAD_VALUES      Delivers Header Node Data to Current Node                   .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_TYPE_ID                   Supplies the Template Category ID                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I GET_VALUE_LIST                Supplies the List of Previously Processed Keys              .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I IS_DONE                       Indicates Whether Node Has Already Been Processed           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_READ          I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Sets the Value of a (Key) Attribute                         .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I ADJUST                        Reevaluates the Complete Product Tree                       .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I CLOSE                         Completes Product Tree Processing                           .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I GET_MULTIPLE_CRM_PRODUCT      Determines All CRM Products for Multiple Product Assignment .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I GET_PRODUCT_PARAMETERS        Supplies all Parameters                                     .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I GET_PROPERTIES_TOP            Supplies Enhanced Characteristics for Initial Product       .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I IS_CHANGED                    Specifies Whether Product Was Changed                       .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I SAVE                          Saves the Complete Product Tree                             .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I SET_NEW_PRODID                Gives a Product ID to a New Copy of the Product             .
IF_ISU_PROD_NODE_TOP_CUST      I SET_PROPERTIES_TOP            Sets Modifiable, Enhanced Characteristics of Initial Prodct .
IF_ISU_SALES_ORDER_SET         I GET_VALUES                    Reads the set values                                        .
IF_ISU_WA_GUARANTORS_DATA      I READ_DATA                     Guarantor Contract Import                                   .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I FREE                          Called to Delete Component                                  .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I GET_ACTIONS                   Provides Action Components                                  .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I PAI_AFTER                     Called After Subscreen Call in PAI                          .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I PAI_BEFORE                    Called Before Subscreen Call in PAI                         .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I PBO_AFTER                     Called After Subscreen Call in PBO                          .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I PBO_BEFORE                    Called Before Subscreen Call in PBO, Provides Subscreen     .
IF_ISU_WF_INBOX_SUB_COMPONENT  I PROCESS_ACTION                Called When Action is Triggered and Executes Action         .
IF_IS_OIL_ACTIVE               I IS_OIL_IS_ACTIVE              The IS-OIL Component Is Active in the System                .
IF_ITAGCY_CCARDDATA            I CCARD_DATA_GET                Delivers Data for Credit Card                               .
IF_ITAGCY_COCTRL               I INIT_DATA                     Initializes Local Data                                      .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_01  I DO_CHECK                      Check Whether Collections Has To Be Executed                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_01  I DO_INIT_DATA                  Initialization of Model Data                                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_01  I DO_UPDATE                     Save Customer-Specific Data                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_02  I DO_CHECK                      Check Whether Collections Has To Be Executed                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_02  I DO_INIT_DATA                  Initialization of Model Data                                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_02  I DO_UPDATE                     Save Customer-Specific Data                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_03  I DO_CHECK                      Check Whether Collections Has To Be Executed                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_03  I DO_INIT_DATA                  Initialization of Model Data                                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_03  I DO_UPDATE                     Save Customer-Specific Data                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_04  I DO_CHECK                      Check Whether Collections Has To Be Executed                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_04  I DO_INIT_DATA                  Initialization of Model Data                                .
IF_ITAGCY_CUSTSCR_LOCATION_04  I DO_UPDATE                     Save Customer-Specific Data                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_DUNNING              I CHECK                         Check Selection Parameters                                  .
IF_ITAGCY_DUNNING              I SELECTION_GET                 Return Selection Parameters                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_DUNNING              I SELECTION_INITIALIZE          Initialize Selection Parameters                             .
IF_ITAGCY_EVENTS               I CHECK_REQUIREMENTS            Supplies Info. on Whether Start Prerequisite is Fulfilled   .
IF_ITAGCY_ORGUNIT              I CHECK                         Check Selection Parameters                                  .
IF_ITAGCY_ORGUNIT              I SELECTION_GET                 Return Selection Parameters                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_ORGUNIT              I SELECTION_INITIALIZE          Initialize Selection Parameters                             .
IF_ITAGCY_REALLOC              I CHECK                         Check Selection Parameters                                  .
IF_ITAGCY_REALLOC              I SELECTION_GET                 Return Selection Parameters                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_REALLOC              I SELECTION_INITIALIZE          Initialize Selection Parameters                             .
IF_ITAGCY_SELECT               I CHECK                         Check Selection Parameters                                  .
IF_ITAGCY_SELECT               I SELECTION_GET                 Return Selection Parameters                                 .
IF_ITAGCY_SELECT               I SELECTION_INITIALIZE          Initialize Selection Parameters                             .
IF_ITAGCY_SUBORG_SEL           I CALLER_DATA_GET               Determines Caller Data                                      .
IF_IXML                        I ACTIVATE                      ACTIVATE                                                    .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_DOCUMENT               CREATE_DOCUMENT                                             .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_ENCODING               CREATE_ENCODING                                             .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_PARSER                 CREATE_PARSER                                               .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_RENDERER               CREATE_RENDERER                                             .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_STREAM_FACTORY         CREATE_STREAM_FACTORY                                       .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_TOKEN_PARSER           CREATE_TOKEN_PARSER                                         .
IF_IXML                        I CREATE_TOKEN_RENDERER         CREATE_TOKEN_RENDERER                                       .
IF_IXML                        I GET_VERSION                   GET_VERSION                                                 .
IF_IXML                        I HAS_FEATURE                   HAS_FEATURE                                                 .
IF_IXML                        I SET_CONVERSION_BEHAVIOUR      SET_CONVERSION_BEHAVIOUR                                    .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE              I GET_OWNER_ELEMENT             GET_OWNER_ELEMENT                                           .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE              I SPECIFIED                     SPECIFIED                                                   .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I ADD_ENUM_VALUE                ADD_ENUM_VALUE                                              .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I ALLOWS_ENUM_VALUE             ALLOWS_ENUM_VALUE                                           .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I GET_ATTR_DEFAULT              GET_ATTR_DEFAULT                                            .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I GET_DEFAULT_VALUE             GET_DEFAULT_VALUE                                           .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I GET_ENUM_VALUE                GET_ENUM_VALUE                                              .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I GET_VALUE_TYPE                GET_VALUE_TYPE                                              .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I REMOVE_ENUM_VALUE             REMOVE_ENUM_VALUE                                           .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I SET_ATTR_DEFAULT              SET_ATTR_DEFAULT                                            .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I SET_DEFAULT_VALUE             SET_DEFAULT_VALUE                                           .
IF_IXML_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         I SET_VALUE_TYPE                SET_VALUE_TYPE                                              .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I APPEND_DATA                   APPEND_DATA                                                 .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I DELETE_DATA                   DELETE_DATA                                                 .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I GET_DATA                      GET_DATA                                                    .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I GET_LENGTH                    GET_LENGTH                                                  .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I INSERT_DATA                   INSERT_DATA                                                 .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I NORMALIZE_DATA                NORMALIZE_DATA                                              .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I REPLACE_DATA                  REPLACE_DATA                                                .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I SET_DATA                      SET_DATA                                                    .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I SUBSTRING_DATA                SUBSTRING_DATA                                              .
IF_IXML_CHARACTER_DATA         I WS_ONLY                       WS_ONLY                                                     .
IF_IXML_COND_DTD_SECTION       I IS_INCLUDE                    IS_INCLUDE                                                  .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I ADD_CONTENT_PARTICLE          ADD_CONTENT_PARTICLE                                        .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I GET_CONTENT_PARTICLE          GET_CONTENT_PARTICLE                                        .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I GET_GROUPING                  GET_GROUPING                                                .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I GET_OCCURRENCE                GET_OCCURRENCE                                              .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I NUM_CONTENT_PARTICLES         NUM_CONTENT_PARTICLES                                       .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I SET_GROUPING                  SET_GROUPING                                                .
IF_IXML_CONTENT_PARTICLE       I SET_OCCURRENCE                SET_OCCURRENCE                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_ATTRIBUTE              CREATE_ATTRIBUTE                                            .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_ATTRIBUTE_NS           CREATE_ATTRIBUTE_NS                                         .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_CDATA_SECTION          CREATE_CDATA_SECTION                                        .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_COMMENT                CREATE_COMMENT                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_DOCUMENT_FRAGMENT      CREATE_DOCUMENT_FRAGMENT                                    .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_DOCUMENT_TYPE          CREATE_DOCUMENT_TYPE                                        .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_ELEMENT                CREATE_ELEMENT                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_ELEMENT_NS             CREATE_ELEMENT_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_ENTITY_REF             CREATE_ENTITY_REF                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_NAMESPACE_DECL         CREATE_NAMESPACE_DECL                                       .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_PI_PARSED              CREATE_PI_PARSED                                            .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_PI_UNPARSED            CREATE_PI_UNPARSED                                          .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_SIMPLE_ELEMENT         CREATE_SIMPLE_ELEMENT                                       .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_SIMPLE_ELEMENT_NS      CREATE_SIMPLE_ELEMENT_NS                                    .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I CREATE_TEXT                   CREATE_TEXT                                                 .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I EXPAND                        EXPAND                                                      .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I FIND_FROM_ID                  FIND_FROM_ID                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I FIND_FROM_NAME                FIND_FROM_NAME                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I FIND_FROM_NAME_NS             FIND_FROM_NAME_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I FIND_FROM_PATH                FIND_FROM_PATH                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I FIND_FROM_PATH_NS             FIND_FROM_PATH_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_DECLARATION               GET_DECLARATION                                             .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_DOCUMENT_TYPE             GET_DOCUMENT_TYPE                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME      GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME                                    .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME_NS   GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME_NS                                 .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_ENCODING                  GET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_ROOT_ELEMENT              GET_ROOT_ELEMENT                                            .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_STANDALONE                GET_STANDALONE                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I GET_VERSION                   GET_VERSION                                                 .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I LINEARIZE                     LINEARIZE                                                   .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I SET_DECLARATION               SET_DECLARATION                                             .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I SET_DOCUMENT_TYPE             SET_DOCUMENT_TYPE                                           .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I SET_ENCODING                  SET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I SET_STANDALONE                SET_STANDALONE                                              .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT               I SET_VERSION                   SET_VERSION                                                 .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_ATTRIBUTE_DECL         CREATE_ATTRIBUTE_DECL                                       .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_ATT_LIST_DECL          CREATE_ATT_LIST_DECL                                        .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_COND_DTD_SECTION       CREATE_COND_DTD_SECTION                                     .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_CONTENT_PARTICLE       CREATE_CONTENT_PARTICLE                                     .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_ELEMENT_DECL           CREATE_ELEMENT_DECL                                         .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_EXT_ENTITY_DECL        CREATE_EXT_ENTITY_DECL                                      .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_INT_ENTITY_DECL        CREATE_INT_ENTITY_DECL                                      .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I CREATE_NOTATION_DECL          CREATE_NOTATION_DECL                                        .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_ENTITIES                  GET_ENTITIES                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_EXPLICIT                  GET_EXPLICIT                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_NOTATIONS                 GET_NOTATIONS                                               .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_PARAM_ENTITIES            GET_PARAM_ENTITIES                                          .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_PUBLIC_ID                 GET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I GET_SYSTEM_ID                 GET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I SET_EXPLICIT                  SET_EXPLICIT                                                .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I SET_PUBLIC_ID                 SET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_DOCUMENT_TYPE          I SET_SYSTEM_ID                 SET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I CONTAINS                      CONTAINS                                                    .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I FIND_FROM_NAME                FIND_FROM_NAME                                              .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I FIND_FROM_NAME_NS             FIND_FROM_NAME_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I FIND_FROM_PATH                FIND_FROM_PATH                                              .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I FIND_FROM_PATH_NS             FIND_FROM_PATH_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 GET_ATTRIBUTE                                               .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE            GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                          .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS         GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS                                       .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NS              GET_ATTRIBUTE_NS                                            .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_CONTENT_AS_STRING         GET_CONTENT_AS_STRING                                       .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME      GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME                                    .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME_NS   GET_ELEMENTS_BY_TAG_NAME_NS                                 .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I NORMALIZE                     NORMALIZE                                                   .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE              REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE                                            .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE         REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                       .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS      REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS                                    .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NS           REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NS                                         .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 SET_ATTRIBUTE                                               .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE            SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                          .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS         SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE_NS                                       .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT                I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NS              SET_ATTRIBUTE_NS                                            .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT_DECL           I GET_CONTENT_SPEC              GET_CONTENT_SPEC                                            .
IF_IXML_ELEMENT_DECL           I SET_CONTENT_SPEC              SET_CONTENT_SPEC                                            .
IF_IXML_ENCODING               I CLONE                         CLONE                                                       .
IF_IXML_ENCODING               I GET_BYTE_ORDER                GET_BYTE_ORDER                                              .
IF_IXML_ENCODING               I GET_CHARACTER_SET             GET_CHARACTER_SET                                           .
IF_IXML_ENCODING               I SET_BYTE_ORDER                SET_BYTE_ORDER                                              .
IF_IXML_ENCODING               I SET_CHARACTER_SET             SET_CHARACTER_SET                                           .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_DECL            I GET_ENTITY_VALUE              GET_ENTITY_VALUE                                            .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_DECL            I GET_NOTATION_NAME             GET_NOTATION_NAME                                           .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_DECL            I GET_PUBLIC_ID                 GET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_DECL            I GET_SYSTEM_ID                 GET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_DECL            I IS_PARAMETER_ENTITY           IS_PARAMETER_ENTITY                                         .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_REF             I GET_PUBLIC_ID                 GET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_ENTITY_REF             I GET_SYSTEM_ID                 GET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_NAME                      GET_NAME                                                    .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_NAMESPACE                 GET_NAMESPACE                                               .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX                                        .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_NODE                      GET_NODE                                                    .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_PARENT                    GET_PARENT                                                  .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_IXML_EVENT                  I GET_VALUE                     GET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I ADVANCE                       ADVANCE                                                     .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I APPEND_CHILD                  APPEND_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I FIND_FROM_GID                 FIND_FROM_GID                                               .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_CHILDREN                  GET_CHILDREN                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_CURRENT                   GET_CURRENT                                                 .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_DEPTH                     GET_DEPTH                                                   .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_FILTER                    GET_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_FIRST_CHILD               GET_FIRST_CHILD                                             .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_GID                       GET_GID                                                     .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_HEIGHT                    GET_HEIGHT                                                  .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_LAST_CHILD                GET_LAST_CHILD                                              .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_NAME                      GET_NAME                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT         GET_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT                                       .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX                                        .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_NAMESPACE_URI             GET_NAMESPACE_URI                                           .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_NEXT                      GET_NEXT                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_OWNER_DOCUMENT            GET_OWNER_DOCUMENT                                          .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_PARENT                    GET_PARENT                                                  .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_PREV                      GET_PREV                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_ROOT                      GET_ROOT                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I GET_VALUE                     GET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I HAS_ANCESTOR                  HAS_ANCESTOR                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I INSERT_CHILD                  INSERT_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I IS_LEAF                       IS_LEAF                                                     .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I IS_ROOT                       IS_ROOT                                                     .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I NUM_CHILDREN                  NUM_CHILDREN                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I REMOVE_CHILD                  REMOVE_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I REMOVE_NODE                   REMOVE_NODE                                                 .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I REPLACE_CHILD                 REPLACE_CHILD                                               .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I RESET                         RESET                                                       .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I SET_FILTER                    SET_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I SET_NAME                      SET_NAME                                                    .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I SET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          SET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX                                        .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I SET_NAMESPACE_URI             SET_NAMESPACE_URI                                           .
IF_IXML_INLINE_ITERATOR        I SET_VALUE                     SET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_IXML_ISTREAM                I GET_NUM_READ                  GET_NUM_READ                                                .
IF_IXML_ISTREAM                I GET_NUM_READ_RAW              GET_NUM_READ_RAW                                            .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I ADVANCE                       Moves the iterator to the next position in an DFS traversal .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_GID                       Returns the GID of the node at the current position         .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_NAME                      Returns the name of the node at the current position        .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_NAMESPACE                 Returns the namespace of the node at the current position   .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_NODE                      Returns an interface reference to the node at the current p..
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_NODE_INFO                 Returns all properties of the node at the current position  .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_TYPE                      Returns the type of the node at the current position        .
IF_IXML_MINI_DFS_ITER          I GET_VALUE                     Returns the value of the node at the current position       .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I ADD_ATTRIBUTE                 Appends an attribute node to the DOM                        .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I ADD_ELEMENT                   Appends an element node to the DOM                          .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I ADD_NODE                      Appends a node to the DOM                                   .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I ADD_TEXT                      Appends a text node to the DOM                              .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I GET_DFS_ITERATOR              Returns an DFS iterator for the DOM                         .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I GET_ROOT_ELEMENT              Returns the root element                                    .
IF_IXML_MINI_DOM               I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Returns the root node                                       .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I ADVANCE_TO_FIRST_CHILD        Advances this node object to the first child of this node   .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I ADVANCE_TO_NEXT               Advances this node object to the next sibling node          .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns this node's attribute by index                      .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns this node's attribute as an internal table          .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_FIRST_CHILD               Returns the node's first child node                         .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_GID                       Returns the node's gid                                      .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_INDEX                     Returns the node's index (internal only)                    .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_NAME                      Returns the node's name                                     .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_NAMESPACE                 Returns the node's namespace                                .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_NEXT                      Returns the node's next sibling node                        .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_NODE_INFO                 Returns a structure containing all of this node's properties.
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_PARENT                    Returns the node's parent node                              .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_TYPE                      Returns the node's type (see IF_IXML_MINI_DOM="CO_NODE_...) .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I GET_VALUE                     Returns the node's value                                    .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I SET_GID                       Sets the node's gid                                         .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I SET_NAME                      Sets the node's name                                        .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I SET_NAMESPACE                 Sets the node's namespace                                   .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I SET_TYPE                      Sets the node's type (see IF_IXML_MINI_DOM="CO_NODE_...)    .
IF_IXML_MINI_NODE              I SET_VALUE                     Sets the node's value                                       .
IF_IXML_MINI_PARSER            I PARSE_STRING                  Parses the given string stream into the output table        .
IF_IXML_MINI_PARSER            I PARSE_TABLE                   Parses the given table stream into the output table         .
IF_IXML_MINI_PARSER            I PARSE_XSTRING                 Parses the given xstring stream into the output table       .
IF_IXML_MINI_RENDERER          I RENDER_STRING                 Renders the given DOM into a string-based stream            .
IF_IXML_MINI_RENDERER          I RENDER_TABLE                  Renders the given DOM into a table-based stream             .
IF_IXML_MINI_RENDERER          I RENDER_XSTRING                Renders the given DOM into a xstring-based stream           .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I CREATE_ITERATOR               CREATE_ITERATOR                                             .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED      CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                    .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR           CREATE_REV_ITERATOR                                         .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED  CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I GET_ITEM                      GET_ITEM                                                    .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I GET_LENGTH                    GET_LENGTH                                                  .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I GET_NAMED_ITEM                GET_NAMED_ITEM                                              .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I GET_NAMED_ITEM_NS             GET_NAMED_ITEM_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I REMOVE_NAMED_ITEM             REMOVE_NAMED_ITEM                                           .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I REMOVE_NAMED_ITEM_NS          REMOVE_NAMED_ITEM_NS                                        .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I SET_NAMED_ITEM                SET_NAMED_ITEM                                              .
IF_IXML_NAMED_NODE_MAP         I SET_NAMED_ITEM_NS             SET_NAMED_ITEM_NS                                           .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I BIND                          BIND                                                        .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I CLONE                         CLONE                                                       .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I GET_BINDING_PREFIX            GET_BINDING_PREFIX                                          .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I GET_BINDING_URI               GET_BINDING_URI                                             .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I MAP_TO_PREFIX                 MAP_TO_PREFIX                                               .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I MAP_TO_URI                    MAP_TO_URI                                                  .
IF_IXML_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT      I NUM_BINDINGS                  NUM_BINDINGS                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I APPEND_CHILD                  APPEND_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CLONE                         CLONE                                                       .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_ANCESTOR        CREATE_FILTER_ANCESTOR                                      .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_AND             CREATE_FILTER_AND                                           .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_ATTRIBUTE       CREATE_FILTER_ATTRIBUTE                                     .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_ATTRIBUTE_NS    CREATE_FILTER_ATTRIBUTE_NS                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_NAME            CREATE_FILTER_NAME                                          .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_NAME_NS         CREATE_FILTER_NAME_NS                                       .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_NODE_TYPE       CREATE_FILTER_NODE_TYPE                                     .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_NOT             CREATE_FILTER_NOT                                           .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_OR              CREATE_FILTER_OR                                            .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_FILTER_PARENT          CREATE_FILTER_PARENT                                        .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_INLINE_ITERATOR        CREATE_INLINE_ITERATOR                                      .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_ITERATOR               CREATE_ITERATOR                                             .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED      CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_REV_INLINE_ITERATOR    CREATE_REV_INLINE_ITERATOR                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR           CREATE_REV_ITERATOR                                         .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED  CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I FIND_FROM_GID                 FIND_FROM_GID                                               .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_CHILDREN                  GET_CHILDREN                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_COLUMN                    GET_COLUMN                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_DEPTH                     GET_DEPTH                                                   .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_FIRST_CHILD               GET_FIRST_CHILD                                             .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_GID                       GET_GID                                                     .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_HEIGHT                    GET_HEIGHT                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_LAST_CHILD                GET_LAST_CHILD                                              .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_LINE                      GET_LINE                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NAME                      GET_NAME                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NAMESPACE                 GET_NAMESPACE                                               .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT         GET_NAMESPACE_CONTEXT                                       .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX                                        .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NAMESPACE_URI             GET_NAMESPACE_URI                                           .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_NEXT                      GET_NEXT                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_OWNER_DOCUMENT            GET_OWNER_DOCUMENT                                          .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_PARENT                    GET_PARENT                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_PREV                      GET_PREV                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_ROOT                      GET_ROOT                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I GET_VALUE                     GET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I HAS_ANCESTOR                  HAS_ANCESTOR                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I INSERT_CHILD                  INSERT_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I IS_LEAF                       IS_LEAF                                                     .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I IS_ROOT                       IS_ROOT                                                     .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I NUM_CHILDREN                  NUM_CHILDREN                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I REMOVE_CHILD                  REMOVE_CHILD                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I REMOVE_NODE                   REMOVE_NODE                                                 .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I REPLACE_CHILD                 REPLACE_CHILD                                               .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I SET_NAME                      SET_NAME                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I SET_NAMESPACE                 SET_NAMESPACE                                               .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I SET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          SET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX                                        .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I SET_NAMESPACE_URI             SET_NAMESPACE_URI                                           .
IF_IXML_NODE                   I SET_VALUE                     SET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I APPEND_ITEM                   APPEND_ITEM                                                 .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I CREATE_ITERATOR               CREATE_ITERATOR                                             .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED      CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR           CREATE_REV_ITERATOR                                         .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED  CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I GET_ITEM                      GET_ITEM                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I GET_LENGTH                    GET_LENGTH                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I INSERT_ITEM                   INSERT_ITEM                                                 .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I REMOVE_ITEM                   REMOVE_ITEM                                                 .
IF_IXML_NODE_COLLECTION        I REPLACE_ITEM                  REPLACE_ITEM                                                .
IF_IXML_NODE_FILTER            I ACCEPT_NODE                   ACCEPT_NODE                                                 .
IF_IXML_NODE_FILTER            I CLONE                         CLONE                                                       .
IF_IXML_NODE_FILTER            I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_FILTER_COMBINING  I ADD_FILTER                    ADD_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE_ITERATOR          I GET_FILTER                    GET_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE_ITERATOR          I GET_NEXT                      GET_NEXT                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_ITERATOR          I RESET                         RESET                                                       .
IF_IXML_NODE_ITERATOR          I SET_FILTER                    SET_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I CREATE_ITERATOR               CREATE_ITERATOR                                             .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED      CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR           CREATE_REV_ITERATOR                                         .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED  CREATE_REV_ITERATOR_FILTERED                                .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I GET_ITEM                      GET_ITEM                                                    .
IF_IXML_NODE_LIST              I GET_LENGTH                    GET_LENGTH                                                  .
IF_IXML_NOTATION_DECL          I GET_PUBLIC_ID                 GET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_NOTATION_DECL          I GET_SYSTEM_ID                 GET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_ESCAPED                   GET_ESCAPED                                                 .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_IGNORE_ESCAPING           GET_IGNORE_ESCAPING                                         .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_INDENT                    GET_INDENT                                                  .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_INDENT_CHAR               GET_INDENT_CHAR                                             .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_NUM_WRITTEN               GET_NUM_WRITTEN                                             .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_NUM_WRITTEN_RAW           GET_NUM_WRITTEN_RAW                                         .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_PRETTY_PRINT              GET_PRETTY_PRINT                                            .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I GET_QUOTED                    GET_QUOTED                                                  .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_ESCAPED                   SET_ESCAPED                                                 .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_IGNORE_ESCAPING           SET_IGNORE_ESCAPING                                         .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_INDENT                    SET_INDENT                                                  .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_INDENT_CHAR               SET_INDENT_CHAR                                             .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_PRETTY_PRINT              SET_PRETTY_PRINT                                            .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I SET_QUOTED                    SET_QUOTED                                                  .
IF_IXML_OSTREAM                I WRITE_STRING                  WRITE_STRING                                                .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I ADD_PRESERVE_SPACE_ELEMENT    ADD_PRESERVE_SPACE_ELEMENT                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I ADD_STRIP_SPACE_ELEMENT       ADD_STRIP_SPACE_ELEMENT                                     .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I GET_ERROR                     GET_ERROR                                                   .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I GET_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION        GET_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION                                      .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I GET_NAMESPACE_MODE            GET_NAMESPACE_MODE                                          .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I HAS_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION        HAS_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION                                      .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I IS_DOM_GENERATING             IS_DOM_GENERATING                                           .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I IS_NORMALIZING                IS_NORMALIZING                                              .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I IS_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS       IS_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS                                     .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I IS_VALIDATING                 IS_VALIDATING                                               .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I IS_XML_SPACE_AWARE            IS_XML_SPACE_AWARE                                          .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I NUM_ERRORS                    NUM_ERRORS                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I PARSE                         PARSE                                                       .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I PARSE_EVENT                   PARSE_EVENT                                                 .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I REGISTER_ENTITY               REGISTER_ENTITY                                             .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_DOM_GENERATING            SET_DOM_GENERATING                                          .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION        SET_EVENT_SUBSCRIPTION                                      .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_NAMESPACE_MODE            SET_NAMESPACE_MODE                                          .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_NORMALIZING               SET_NORMALIZING                                             .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_RESOLVE_MODE              SET_RESOLVE_MODE                                            .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS      SET_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS                                    .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_VALIDATING                SET_VALIDATING                                              .
IF_IXML_PARSER                 I SET_XML_SPACE_AWARE           SET_XML_SPACE_AWARE                                         .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_COLUMN                    GET_COLUMN                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_ENTITY                    GET_ENTITY                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_LINE                      GET_LINE                                                    .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_NUMBER                    GET_NUMBER                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_OFFSET                    GET_OFFSET                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_REASON                    GET_REASON                                                  .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_SEVERITY                  GET_SEVERITY                                                .
IF_IXML_PARSE_ERROR            I GET_SEVERITY_TEXT             GET_SEVERITY_TEXT                                           .
IF_IXML_PI                     I GET_TARGET                    GET_TARGET                                                  .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 GET_ATTRIBUTE                                               .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE            GET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                          .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE              REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE                                            .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE         REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                       .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 SET_ATTRIBUTE                                               .
IF_IXML_PI_PARSED              I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE            SET_ATTRIBUTE_NODE                                          .
IF_IXML_PI_UNPARSED            I APPEND_DATA                   APPEND_DATA                                                 .
IF_IXML_PI_UNPARSED            I GET_DATA                      GET_DATA                                                    .
IF_IXML_PI_UNPARSED            I SET_DATA                      SET_DATA                                                    .
IF_IXML_RENDERER               I IS_NORMALIZING                IS_NORMALIZING                                              .
IF_IXML_RENDERER               I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IF_IXML_RENDERER               I SET_NORMALIZING               SET_NORMALIZING                                             .
IF_IXML_RENDERER               I SET_NO_ESCAPING               SET_NO_ESCAPING                                             .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I CLONE                         CLONE                                                       .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I CLOSE                         CLOSE                                                       .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I GET_ENCODING                  GET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I GET_PUBLIC_ID                 GET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I GET_SYSTEM_ID                 GET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I IS_CAPABLE                    IS_CAPABLE                                                  .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I MAKE_ABSOLUTE_ID              MAKE_ABSOLUTE_ID                                            .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I OPEN                          OPEN                                                        .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I SET_ENCODING                  SET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I SET_PUBLIC_ID                 SET_PUBLIC_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_STREAM                 I SET_SYSTEM_ID                 SET_SYSTEM_ID                                               .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_ISTREAM_CSTRING        CREATE_ISTREAM_CSTRING                                      .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_ISTREAM_ITABLE         CREATE_ISTREAM_ITABLE                                       .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_ISTREAM_STRING         CREATE_ISTREAM_STRING                                       .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_ISTREAM_URI            CREATE_ISTREAM_URI                                          .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_ISTREAM_XSTRING        CREATE_ISTREAM_XSTRING                                      .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_OSTREAM_CSTRING        CREATE_OSTREAM_CSTRING                                      .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_OSTREAM_ITABLE         CREATE_OSTREAM_ITABLE                                       .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_OSTREAM_URI            CREATE_OSTREAM_URI                                          .
IF_IXML_STREAM_FACTORY         I CREATE_OSTREAM_XSTRING        CREATE_OSTREAM_XSTRING                                      .
IF_IXML_TEXT                   I SPLIT_TEXT                    SPLIT_TEXT                                                  .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I ADD_FILTER                    ADD_FILTER                                                  .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I ADD_PRESERVE_SPACE_ELEMENT    ADD_PRESERVE_SPACE_ELEMENT                                  .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I ADD_STRIP_SPACE_ELEMENT       ADD_STRIP_SPACE_ELEMENT                                     .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I FIND_END_ELEMENT              FIND_END_ELEMENT                                            .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                GET_ATTRIBUTES                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_ERROR                     GET_ERROR                                                   .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_NAMESPACES                GET_NAMESPACES                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_NAMESPACE_MODE            GET_NAMESPACE_MODE                                          .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_NEXT_TOKEN                GET_NEXT_TOKEN                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_NODE_INFO                 GET_NODE_INFO                                               .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I GET_TREE_LEVEL                GET_TREE_LEVEL                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I IS_DOM_GENERATING             IS_DOM_GENERATING                                           .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I IS_NORMALIZING                IS_NORMALIZING                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I IS_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS       IS_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS                                     .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I IS_VALIDATING                 IS_VALIDATING                                               .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I IS_XML_SPACE_AWARE            IS_XML_SPACE_AWARE                                          .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I NUM_ERRORS                    NUM_ERRORS                                                  .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I PARSE_TOKENS                  PARSE_TOKENS                                                .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I REGISTER_ENTITY               REGISTER_ENTITY                                             .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I REMOVE_FILTER                 REMOVE_FILTER                                               .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_DOM_GENERATING            SET_DOM_GENERATING                                          .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_NAMESPACE_MODE            SET_NAMESPACE_MODE                                          .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_NORMALIZING               SET_NORMALIZING                                             .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS      SET_SUPPLY_ATTR_DEFAULTS                                    .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_VALIDATING                SET_VALIDATING                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_PARSER           I SET_XML_SPACE_AWARE           SET_XML_SPACE_AWARE                                         .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I GET_ENCODING                  GET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I IS_NORMALIZING                IS_NORMALIZING                                              .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I SET_ENCODING                  SET_ENCODING                                                .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I SET_NORMALIZING               SET_NORMALIZING                                             .
IF_IXML_TOKEN_RENDERER         I SET_NO_ESCAPING               SET_NO_ESCAPING                                             .
IF_IXML_UNKNOWN                I QUERY_INTERFACE               QUERY_INTERFACE                                             .
IF_JBR_SOFT_MODIFICATIONS      I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Load Attributes of Modification (Optional)                  .
IF_JBR_SOFT_MODIFICATIONS      I IS_ACTIVE                     Query for a Note: Is Modification Active?                   .
IF_J_1B_CIAP_OBJECT            I COLLECT_X4_RSEG               Collect X4_RSEG data                                        .
IF_KCRM_ERR_CP                 I GIVE_MARKED_OBJECTS           Delivers the Selected Objects                               .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I DELETE_GROUP                  Delete Group                                                .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I GET_GROUPS                    Read Groups                                                 .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I GET_SINGLE_GROUP              Read Single Group                                           .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I INSERT_GROUP                  Insert Group                                                .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I QUERY                         Value Conversion                                            .
IF_KMP_SERVICE                 I REPLACE                       Delete and Insert Groups                                    .
IF_LAST_AMORT_CAL              I GET_LAST_AMORTIZATION         Gets Date and Amortized Acquisition Value of Last Amort.    .
IF_LBK_FOLDER_ACL              I GET_CNTR_UPD_DEF              Returns counter update definition in Logbook customizing    .
IF_LDAP_GENERIC_DYNPRO         I PAI                           Is Called for PAI                                           .
IF_LDAP_GENERIC_DYNPRO         I PBO                           Is Called for PBO                                           .
IF_LE_SHP_MAP_EXTERNAL_INTERFA I MAP_EXTERNAL_TO_INTERNAL      Data Transfer from External to Internal Interface           .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I CHECK_FOR_DETERM_PROC         Check If This Is an Allowed Procedure                       .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I CHECK_FOR_PARTNER_FCT         Check If Partner Function is Allowed for Procedure          .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_DETERM_PROC_DESCR         Get Description of a Procedure                              .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_F4_HELP_DETERM_PROC       Gives the Allowed Partner Determination Procedures          .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_F4_HELP_PARTNERFUNCTIONS  Gives the Partner Function to a Procedure                   .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_PARTNER_FCT_CUST          Get Customizing Details for Partner Functions               .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_PARTNER_FCT_DESCR         Get Description of Partner Function                         .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_CUST           I GET_PARTNER_FCT_KEY           Get Key for Partner Function Description                    .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_OBJECTTYPE     I CHECK_PARENTOBJECT            Checks if Relationship Maintenance Is Allowed               .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_OBJECTTYPE     I GET_F4_HELP_PARTNERFUNCTIONS  States Partner Functions for All Partner Determ. Procedures .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_OBJECTTYPE     I GET_PARENTOBJECT_ID           Determines the ID for a Given GUID (No Error-Handling)      .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_OBJECTTYPE     I GET_PARTNER_DETERM_PROC       Determines the Partner Procedure for a Parent GUID          .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_PART           I CHECK_PARTNER_EXISTS          Checks if Partner Exists                                    .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_PART           I GET_PARTNER_DATA              Reads Partner Data (Name, ...) for Assigned Partner         .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_PART           I GET_PARTNER_GUID              Determine the Guid for the ID                               .
IF_LINK_PARTNER_PART           I GET_PARTNER_ID                Determine the ID for the Guid                               .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I CHECK_ENRICH_ATTRIBUTES       Enrichment of the Attributes of a Relationship              .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I CHECK_EXTENDED_KEYS           Check Extended Keys                                         .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I CONVERT_FIELDVALUES           Conversion of Fields                                        .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I FILL_DDLB                     People Centric IL: Filling  Dropdown List Box               .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I FILL_F4                       Filling F4 Return Values                                    .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I GET_DESTINOBJECT_GUID         Determination of Target Object GUID                         .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I GET_F4_NO_DIALOG              Filling F4 Return Values without Dialog                     .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I LINK_SCC                      Controlling Field Attributes (Screen Control)               .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I MAP_UIDATA_MODIFY             Maps Key Data of Structures                                 .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I MAP_UIDATA_READ               Maps Key Data of Structures                                 .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I SORT_LINKS                    Sort and Filter Display                                     .
IF_LINK_RELTYPE_UI             I UPDATE_OUTTAB                 Filling Output Line with Additional Data                    .
IF_LINK_SERVICE                I GET_ITEM_LINKS                Determines the Relationships to a cl_browser_item           .
IF_LIST_TREE_MODEL_ITEM_PROV   I LOAD_ITEMS                    Load Items on Demand                                        .
IF_LOCK_OWNER_TRL              I CHECK_LOCK                    Check Lock                                                  .
IF_LOCK_OWNER_TRL              I GET_GUID                      Get GUI of Lock Owner                                       .
IF_LOCK_OWNER_TRL              I REPOSTING_CALLBACK            Action Following Removal of Lock                            .
IF_LOCK_OWNER_TRL              I UNLOCK                        Remove block                                                .
IF_LOCK_PPF                    I DEQUEUE                       Remove Lock                                                 .
IF_LOCK_PPF                    I ENQUEUE                       Generate Lock                                               .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I ADOPT_TEXT                    Adopt Long Text                                             .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Long Text                                            .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I EDIT_TEXT                     Invoke Long Text Editor                                     .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I GET_TEXT                      Read Long Text per Text ID                                  .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I GET_TEXTOBJECT                Supplies Text Object (TTXOB)                                .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I GET_TYPES                     Text Types                                                  .
IF_LONGTEXTS_MM                I SET_TEXT                      Set Long Text per Text ID                                   .
IF_LPD_LIGHT_PROVIDER          I GETOBJECTS                    Get the objects for LPD Light                               .
IF_LPD_LIGHT_PROVIDER          I GETOBJECTTYPE                 Get the objecttypes for LPD Light                           .
IF_LPD_LIGHT_PROVIDER          I GETPARAMETERS                 Get the parameters for LPD Light                            .
IF_LSO_COL_MANAGER             I GET                           Delivers Instance of a Collaboration                        .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I COMPLETE                      End Collaboration                                           .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I COMPLETE_PARTICIPANT          Stop Participation                                          .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I DELETE                        Delete Collaboration                                        .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I DELETE_PARTICIPANT            Delete/Cancel Participants                                  .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I GET_INFORMATION               Delivers Information as Property List                       .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I GET_PARTICIPANTS              Delivers List of All Participants                           .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I INSERT_PARTICIPANT            Add Participants                                            .
IF_LSO_COL_ROOM                I IS_PARTICIPANT                Is Learner/User Participant in Room                         .
IF_LSO_CRP_COMMUNICATION_DATA  I GET_COMMUNICATION_DATA        Communication Data for Specific Person                      .
IF_LSO_CRP_CONFLICT_HANDLER    I FIND_AND_RESOLVE              Find and Resolve Conflicts                                  .
IF_LSO_CRP_CONTEXT_PREP        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_LSO_CRP_CONTEXT_PREP        I PREPARE_CONTEXT               Prepare Context                                             .
IF_LSO_CRP_CONTEXT_UI          I GET_INSTANCE                  Singleton                                                   .
IF_LSO_CRP_CONTEXT_UI          I SHOW_DIALOG                   Display Dialog                                              .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_CRUD          I ADD_CONTEXT                   Add Correspondence Requests                                 .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_CRUD          I DELETE_CONTEXT                Delete Correspondence Requests                              .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_CRUD          I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Change Correspondence Requests                              .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I ADD_CONTEXT                   Add Requests                                                .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I COPY_CONTEXT                  Copy Request                                                .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I DELETE_CONTEXT                Delete Requests                                             .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I PREVIEW_CONTEXT               Get Request for Preview                                     .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I SEND_CONTEXT                  Send Requests                                               .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I SET_COMMIT                    Specify Commit Behavior                                     .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I SIGNAL_GENERATE_OK            Requests were generated successfully                        .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I SIGNAL_SEND_ERROR             Requests could not be sent                                  .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I SIGNAL_SEND_OK                Requests were sent                                          .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_MANAGER       I UPDATE_CONTEXT                Change Requests                                             .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_QUERY         I GET_CONTEXT                   Returns List of Correspondence Requests                     .
IF_LSO_CRP_QUEUE_QUERY         I IS_EMPTY                      Queue is empty                                              .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_CELL_PHONE                Determine Cell Phone Address for Address Type               .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_CELL_PHONE_LIST           Available Addresses for SMS/Pager                           .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_FAX                       Determine Fax Address for Address Type                      .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_FAX_LIST                  Available Fax Numbers                                       .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_ID                        Returns unique ID for recipient                             .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_IMAIL                     Determine Internet mail address for address type            .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_IMAIL_LIST                Available Internet Addresses                                .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_NAME                      Returns display name                                        .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_PHONE_LIST                Available Telephone Numbers                                 .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_RMAIL                     SAP Mail: Determine Address for Address Type                .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_RMAIL_LIST                Available SAP Mail Addresses                                .
IF_LSO_CRP_RECIPIENT           I GET_TELNR                     Returns phone numbers                                       .
IF_LSO_CRP_RENDER_READER       I GET_INSTANCE                  Creating Instance                                           .
IF_LSO_CRP_RENDER_READER       I READ_VALUE                    Import Value for Key                                        .
IF_LSO_CRP_SMM_STORAGE         I DELETE_STOPMARK               Delete Stopmarks                                            .
IF_LSO_CRP_SMM_STORAGE         I GET_STOPMARK                  Read Stopmarks                                              .
IF_LSO_CRP_SMM_STORAGE         I SET_STOPMARK                  Set Stopmarks                                               .
IF_LSO_LEARNER                 I GET_PRICING_INFO              Returns Data on Price Determination                         .
IF_LSO_LEARNER                 I GET_SETTINGS                  Returns Personalization Data                                .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I REFRESH_VALUES                Re-Read All Data                                            .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SAVE_VALUES                   Save Changes                                                .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_CATALOG_TTYPES            Catalog: Display Course Types                               .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_CATALOG_VIEWS             Catalog: Set View                                           .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_LEARNING_STRATEGY         Set Learning Strategy                                       .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_SEARCH_LANGUAGE           Find: Set Preferred Language                                .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_SEARCH_LOCATION           Find: Set Preferred Location                                .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_SEARCH_USE_SETTINGS       Find: Use Settings                                          .
IF_LSO_LEARNER_SETTINGS        I SET_TRAININGTYPE_READ_NDAYS   Preview Period in Days                                      .
IF_LSO_WS_ELSP_SERVICE         I ENROLL_USER                   Book for external course                                    .
IF_LSO_WS_ELSP_SERVICE         I GET_USER_TRACKING             Read Learning Data                                          .
IF_LSO_WS_ELSP_SERVICE         I LAUNCH_COURSE                 Launch of external course                                   .
IF_LSO_WS_ELSP_SERVICE         I SET_USER_TRACKING             Write Learning Data                                         .
IF_LSO_WS_ELSP_SERVICE         I UNENROLL_USER                 Cancellation of external course                             .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I ACTIVATE                      BRF: Maintenance - Activates a BRF Object (Version Mgmnt)   .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I CHANGE_EDIT_MODE              BRF: Maintenance - Switches Edit Mode                       .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I CHECK_AUTHORITY               BRF: Maintenance - Authorization Check                      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I CLEAR                         BRF: Maintenance - Clears Instance Data                     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I COPY                          BRF: Maintenance - Copy                                     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I CREATE_EXPORT_OBJECT          BRF: Maintenance - Create Transport Object                  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I DEQUEUE                       BRF: Maintenance: Unlocks Tables (Lines) to Be Maintained   .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I ENQUEUE                       BRF: Maintenance - Locks Tables (Lines) to Be Maintained    .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I FMOD                          BRF: Maintenance - Field Modification Data Screen           .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I FMOD_ENTRY                    BRF: Maintenance - Field Modification Initial Screen        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I FMOD_TABLE                    BRF: Maintenance - Fld Modif. f. Table Control on Data Scrn .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I FREE                          BRF: Maintenance - Clearing Controls                        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_EDIT_MODE                 BRF: Maintenance - Returns Edit Mode                        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_ENTRY_SCREENS             BRF: Maintenance - Returns Initial Subscreens               .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_KEY_STRUCTURE             BRF: Maintenance - Transfers Uncategorized Key Information  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_MENUE                     BRF: Maintenance - Transfers Menu to Be Used Now (GUI)      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_MNT_INSTANCE              BRF: Maintenance - Returns Maintenance Instance             .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_MNT_INSTANCE_ENTRY        BRF: Maintenance - Returns Maint.Instance f.Initial Screen  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_PROGRESS_STATUS           BRF: Maintenance - Returns PROGRESS_STATUS                  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SCREENS                   BRF: Maintenance - Returns List of Maintenance Subscreens   .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SCREEN_STATE              BRF: Maintenance - Returns State of Maintenance Screen      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SCREEN_STRUCTURE          BRF: Maintenance - Returns Screen Structure, Data Screen    .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SCREEN_STRUCTURE_ENTRY    BRF: Maintenance - Returns Screen Structure, Initial Screen .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SCREEN_TABLE              BRF: Maintenance - Returns Screen Table, Data Screen        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_SMARTFORM_NAME            BRF: Maintenance - Returns Name of SmartForm                .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_TABLE_FOR_ALV_GRID        BRF: Maintenance -Transfers Detail Table Acc. to Selection  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_TITLE                     BRF: Maintenance - Title of Maintenance Screen              .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_TRANSPORT_OBJECTS         BRF: Maintenance - Returns Affected Transport Objects       .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_VERSION_INFO              BRF: Maintenance - Delivers Information on a New Version    .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GET_XML                       BRF: Maintenance - Returns XML Representation               .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GOTO_NEXT_OBJECT              BRF: Maintenance - Goes to Next Object                      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I GOTO_PREV_OBJECT              BRF: Maintenance - Goes to Previous Object                  .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I HISTORY_IS_ACTIVE             BRF: Maintenance: History Management Is Available And Active.
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I INIT                          BRF: Maintenance - Initialization                           .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I IS_MODIFIED                   BRF: Maintenance - Has Object Been Changed?                 .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I LOAD                          BRF: Maintenance - Load                                     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PAI1                          BRF: Maintenance - PAI, Checks After Input, Data Screen     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PAI2                          BRF: Maintenance - PAI, Transfer of Data After Input        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PAI_CONTROL                   BRF: Maintenance - PAI, Return Controls                     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PAI_ENTRY                     BRF: Maintenance - PAI, Initial Screen                      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PBO1                          BRF: Maintenance - Set PBO Fields, Data Screen              .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PBO2                          BRF: Maintenance - Set PBO Texts, Data Screen               .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PBO_CONTROL                   BRF: Maintenance - PBO, Set Up / Update Controls            .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PBO_ENTRY                     BRF: Maintenance - PBO, Initial Screen                      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PRINT                         BRF: Print Individual Expressions                           .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PROCESS_EXIT_FUNCTION         BRF: Maintenance - Processes Exit Function Code             .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I PROCESS_NORMAL_FUNCTION       BRF: Maintenance - Processes Normal Function Code           .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SAVE                          BRF: Maintenance - Save                                     .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SAVE_PREPARE                  BRF: Maintenance - Prepare Saving (Transport, etc.)         .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SET_SCREEN_STRUCTURE          BRF: Maintenance - Sets Screen Structure, Data Screen       .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SET_SCREEN_STRUCTURE_ENTRY    BRF: Maintenance - Sets Screen Structure, Initial Screen    .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SET_SCREEN_TABLE              BRF: Maintenance - Sets Screen Table, Data Screen           .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SET_SMARTFORM_NAME            BRF: Maintenance - Sets SmartForm Name                      .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SET_TOP_LINE                  BRF: Maintenance - for Table Control                        .
IF_MAINTENANCE_BRF             I SYNC                          BRF: Maintenance - Sends Change Information per 00 Event    .
IF_MAPPING                     I EXECUTE                       Execute Transformation                                      .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I ADD_RECORD                    Inserts an Entry or Changes an Existing Entry               .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I GET_ALL_RECORDS               Gets All Entries                                            .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I GET_RECORD                    Gets One Entry                                              .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I GET_RECORDS_OF_NAMESPACE      Gets All Entries for a Namespace                            .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I REMOVE_ALL_RECORDS            Deletes All Lines                                           .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I REMOVE_RECORD                 Deletes One Entry                                           .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I REMOVE_RECORDS_OF_NAMESPACE   Deletes All Entries for a Namespace                         .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I SET_ALL_RECORDS               Sets the Table of All Entries                               .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I SIZE                          Gets the Number of All Entries                              .
IF_MAPPING_DYNAMIC_CONF        I SIZE_OF_NAMESPACE             Gets the Number of All Entries of a Namespace               .
IF_MAPPING_PARAM               I GET                           Returning a Parameter                                       .
IF_MAPPING_SUPPORT_DETAILS     I GET_DETAILS                   XML Documents Between Mapping Steps                         .
IF_MAPPING_SUPPORT_DETAILS     I SET_TEST_MODE                 Set Test Mode                                               .
IF_MAPPING_TRACE               I TRACE                         Write Trace                                                 .
IF_MAPPING_TRACE               I TRACE1                        Write Trace (Level 1: Important Messages)                   .
IF_MAPPING_TRACE               I TRACE2                        Write Trace (Level 2: Normal Messages)                      .
IF_MAPPING_TRACE               I TRACE3                        Write Trace (Level 3: Details)                              .
IF_MASS_PROCESSING_IMP         I END_SELECT                    Final Call                                                  .
IF_MASS_PROCESSING_IMP         I PROCESS                       Executes Processing of Objects                              .
IF_MASS_PROCESSING_IMP         I REFRESH                       Deletes Objects and Parameters After Processing             .
IF_MASS_PROCESSING_IMP         I SELECT                        Determines Objects to Be Processed                          .
IF_MASTER_CONDITIONS_MM        I GET_DATA                      Deliver Master Conditions                                   .
IF_MASTER_CONDITIONS_MM        I SET_DATA                      Set Master Conditions                                       .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I ADD_MINUTES                   Add Log Records                                             .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I CHECK_FIELDCATALOGUE          Check Changed Data                                          .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I FREE                          Initialization Type                                         .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I GET_FIELDCATALOGUE_DATA       Pass on Default Values During First Call                    .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I GET_SAISON_DATA               Copy Season Periods                                         .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I SAVE_CHANGES                  Update changes                                              .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I SET_DATA_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY    Copy Default Values During First Call                       .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I SET_FIELDCATALOGUE            Transfer Changed Field Values                               .
IF_MATERIAL_MAINTAINDATA       I UPDATE_MATERIALLIST           Adjust List of Edited Materials                             .
IF_MATERIAL_SPECIALIZATION     I CREATE_NEW_SPECIALIZATION     Create new specialization                                   .
IF_MATERIAL_SPECIALIZATION     I GET_SPECIALIZATION            Read type of specialization                                 .
IF_MATERIAL_SPECIALIZATION     I GET_SPECIALIZATIONS           Read types of a table of specialization                     .
IF_MCEX_45_ADDON               I FILL_ITEM_ADDON               Filling of Item Extractor                                   .
IF_MCEX_45_CDLST_ADDON         I FILL_ADDON_DATA               Enrich Add-On Data for Append DataSource                    .
IF_MCEX_45_ITM_ADDON           I FILL_ITEM_DATA                Fill Add-On Data                                            .
IF_MCEX_45_PDLST_ADDON         I FILL_ADDON_DATA               Enrich Add-On Data for Append DataSource                    .
IF_MCEX_45_VDLST_ADDON         I FILL_ADDON_DATA               Enrich Add-On Data for Append DataSource                    .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I DELETE_DS_CONFIG              MDM-BI: delete data source configuration                    .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I HANDLE_BI_CLEANUP_NOTIFY      MDM-BI: Cleanup notification handler                        .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I HANDLE_BI_DATA_CREATION_NOTIFYMDM-BI: Data creation notification handler                  .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I HANDLE_BI_DATA_READ_NOTIFY    MDM-BI: Data read notification handler                      .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I HANDLE_BI_METADATA_NOTIFY     MDM-BI: Meta data notification handler                      .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I SET_DS_CONFIG                 MDM-BI: set configuration required for the Data Source      .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I SET_RECORDS                   MDM-BI: buffer extracted record IDs                         .
IF_MDE_BI_CONTROLLER           I SET_STATUS_TO_PROCESSED       MDM-BI: set status to processed for extracted records       .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I AUTHORITY_CHECK               MDM-BI: check user authority                                .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I CLEANUP                       MDM-BI: Cleanup Field Mapping and Repository                .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I CREATE                        MDM-BI: Create Data Records                                 .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I GENERATE                      MDM-BI: Generate Field Mapping and Repository               .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I GET_LISTENER                  MDM-BI: Get Listener Instance for Tracing                   .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I MODIFY                        MDM-BI: Modify Field Mapping and Repository                 .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I READ                          MDM-BI: Read Data Records                                   .
IF_MDE_BI_MAPPING              I SET_STATUS                    MDM-BI: Set record status in MDM                            .
IF_MDE_BI_TABLE_MAP            I DEL_META_DATA                 MDM-BI: Delete meta data from table                         .
IF_MDE_BI_TABLE_MAP            I GET_META_DATA                 MDM-BI: Get meta data from table                            .
IF_MDE_BI_TABLE_MAP            I SET_META_DATA                 MDM-BI: Set meta data to table                              .
IF_MDM_CLNTDEL_OBJ_CTRL        I PROCESS_REQUEST               Process request                                             .
IF_MDS_CTRL_EVENT_HANDLER      I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_MDS_CTRL_EVENT_HANDLER      I START                         Start Processing                                            .
IF_MDS_CTRL_STRATEGY_IMPL      I FLUSH                         Lock Flush                                                  .
IF_MDS_CTRL_STRATEGY_IMPL      I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_MDS_CTRL_STRATEGY_IMPL      I LOCK                          Set Locks                                                   .
IF_MDS_CTRL_STRATEGY_IMPL      I PROCESS                       Central Maintenance                                         .
IF_MDS_CTRL_STRATEGY_IMPL      I UNLOCK                        Undo Locks                                                  .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I EXTRACT_DATA                  Extraction of Object Data                                   .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I EXTRACT_ID                    Extraction of Object Keys                                   .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I FINALIZE                      Terminates Data Extraction                                  .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I FINALIZE_ID                   Terminates ID Selection                                     .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I GET_SEL_KIND_DESC             Reads the Text for Relevant Selection Types                 .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I HAS_RELATIONS                 Checks Whether Object Has Relations                         .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I HAS_TEST_MODE                 Returns Information on Whether Sync. Object Has a Test Mode .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Data Extract                              .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR               I INITIALIZE_ID                 Initialization of ID Extraction                             .
IF_MDS_EXTRACTOR_INST          I GET_INSTANCE                  Generates an Extractor Instance                             .
IF_MEDIUM_CONTAINER_PPF        I GET_CONTAINER                 Read Container of Medium                                    .
IF_MEDIUM_CONTAINER_PPF        I SAVE_CONTAINER                Save Container of Medium (for Event Handler)                .
IF_MEDIUM_CONTAINER_PPF        I SET_CONTAINER                 Set Container of Medium                                     .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I CHECK                         Check Consistency                                           .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I COPY                          Copy Medium                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_CHANGED                   Delivers Flag, Whether Instance Was Changed                 .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_MEDIUM                    Generates a Runtime Medium from the Customizing Medium      .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_MEDIUM_TEMPLATE           Generates a Template Medium (Persistent) from Cust. Medium  .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_MEDIUM_TEMPLATE_TRANS     DO NOT USE!!!                                               .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_PERSISTENCY_TABLE         Delivers the Table Where the Data Is Persistently Stored    .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I GET_TYPE                      Delivers the Type of the Medium                             .
IF_MEDIUM_CUST_PPF             I TRANSPORT                     Include Additional Data in Transport Request                .
IF_MEDIUM_PARTNER_PPF          I GET_PARTNER                   Get Partner                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_PARTNER_PPF          I PARTNER_IS_EQUAL              Compare Partner                                             .
IF_MEDIUM_PARTNER_PPF          I SET_PARTNER                   Set Partner                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I CHECK                         Check Medium                                                .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I COMPLETE                      Complete Medium                                             .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I COPY                          Copy Medium                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I DELETE                        Delete Medium and Attached Data                             .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I EXECUTE                       Start Processing                                            .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I GET_MEDIUM_TEXT               Read Media Configuration as Text                            .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I GET_PARTNER                   Get Partner                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I GET_PROCESSING_LOG            Get Processing Log                                          .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I GET_STATUS_TEXT               Read Status as Text                                         .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I GET_TYPE                      Get Medium Type (Print, Fax, Mail ..)                       .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I IS_EQUAL                      Compare Medium                                              .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I LANGUAGE_IS_EQUAL             Compare Medium Language                                     .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I MEDIUM_CHANGED                Manually Changed?                                           .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I PARTNER_IS_EQUAL              Compare Partner                                             .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I PREVIEW                       Display Preview                                             .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I SET_PARTNER                   Set Partner                                                 .
IF_MEDIUM_PPF                  I SET_TRIGGER                   Set Action                                                  .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I CHECK                         Check Consistency                                           .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I COPY                          Create by Copying                                           .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I DELETE                        Deletes the Template and Attached Data                      .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_INVALID                   Delivers Flag if Template Has Been Invalidated              .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_MEDIUM                    Generates a Runtime Medium from the Template                .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_MEDIUM_TEXT               Read Media Configuration as Text                            .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_NEXT                      Delivers the Next Media Template                            .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_PERSISTENCY_TABLE         Delivers the Table Where the Data Is Persistently Stored    .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I GET_TYPE                      Get Medium Type (Print, Fax, Mail ..)                       .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I SET_NEXT                      Sets the Next Media Template                                .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I SET_USECUSTDATA               Data will be reset to the Customizing values                .
IF_MEDIUM_TEMPL_PPF            I TRANSPORT_REQUESTED           Transport Is Triggered, Enter Dependent Objects             .
IF_MEDIUM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_CUSTOMIZING_SUBSCR        Delivers Report ID and Subscreen for Customizing            .
IF_MEDIUM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_DETERMINATION_SUBSCR      Delivers Report ID and Subscreen for Determination          .
IF_MEDIUM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_RUNTIME_SUBSCR            Delivers Report ID and Subscreen for Runtime Environment    .
IF_MEDIUM_VIEW_PPF             I GET_WIZARD_SUBSCR             Delivers Report ID and Subscreen for Customizing Wizard     .
IF_MEDIUM_VIEW_PPF             I PUBLISH                       Sets the Corresponding Model                                .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I COPY                          Copies this Instance                                        .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I GET_CHANGED                   Delivers Flag, Whether Instance Was Changed                 .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers a Merge Instance for an Action Definition          .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I GET_MERGE_TEXT                Delivers Description of the Logic Used                      .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I GET_PERSISTENCY_TABLE         Delivers the Table Where the Data Is Persistently Stored    .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I MERGE                         Mix of New and Existing Actions                             .
IF_MERGE_PPF                   I MERGE_SINGLE                  Mix Man. Created and Existing Actions                       .
IF_MERGE_SPLIT_SERVICE         I MERGE_AND_SPLIT               Merge and Split of Message Objects                          .
IF_MERGE_VIEW_PPF              I GET_MODEL_CLASS               Delivers the Model Class                                    .
IF_MERGE_VIEW_PPF              I GET_SUBSCR                    Delivers Report ID and Subscreen                            .
IF_MERGE_VIEW_PPF              I PUBLISH                       Sets the Corresponding Model                                .
IF_MESSAGE                     I GET_LONGTEXT                  Returns message long text                                   .
IF_MESSAGE                     I GET_TEXT                      Returns message short text                                  .
IF_MESSAGE_LINK_OBJECT         I SET_OBJECT_ID                 Set Business Object Key                                     .
IF_MESSAGE_LINK_OBJECT         I WRITE                         Save Object Link                                            .
IF_MESSAGE_OBJ_MM              I DESCRIBE                      Object Description                                          .
IF_MESSAGE_OBJ_MM              I GET_PARENT                    Determine Parent Object                                     .
IF_MESSAGE_PART                I SET_TRANSFER_ENCODING         Sets Content Transfer Encoding                              .
IF_METACLASS_MM                I GET_CLASS_ID                  Class ID                                                    .
IF_METACLASS_MM                I GET_CLASS_ID_FOR_INSTANCE     Class ID for Instance                                       .
IF_ME_CATALOG_INTERFACE        I DETERMINE_TEXT_ID             Determine a Different Text id for Current Item              .
IF_ME_CATALOG_INTERFACE        I MAP_CAT_VALUES                Concatenate Catalog Fields to Item Fields                   .
IF_ME_CATALOG_INTERFACE        I MATGROUP_ECC_TO_CCM           Replace the Technical Representation of a Material Group    .
IF_ME_COMMITMENT_PLAN          I OPEN                          Open Commitment Plan                                        .
IF_ME_COMMITMENT_PLAN          I PROCESS                       Check Commitment Plan                                       .
IF_ME_DELIVERY_TIME_VARIANCE   I CHANGE_VARIANCE               Change Delivery Time Variance                               .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I CHANGE_SI_CATEGORY            Change of Subitem Category in PIC                           .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I CHECK_ERP_PIC                 Check Whether PIC to be Executed in ERP                     .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I PIC_ATPCA                     Change in Transfer Structure for ATP Check                  .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I PIC_ATPCSX                    Changes to Transfer Table for ATP Check                     .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I SET_SCM_PIC                   Decision Whether PIC is to be Executed in SCM               .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I SI_TABLES                     Change of Data for Subitems                                 .
IF_ME_PIC_STO_EXTEND           I TRIGGER_SUBITEM_CHANGE        Change in Subitems in Case of ATP from Subitems             .
IF_ME_SUBITEM_FIELDSTATUS      I OVERRIDE_WEPOS                Allows to Override the Settings from Customizing (T163)     .
IF_ME_WRF_STD_DNG              I FASHION_DUNNING_CHECK         Remind and Expedite: Change Reminder/Expediting Date        .
IF_MIME_PART                   I SET_TRANSFER_ENCODING         Set (Content Transfer) Encoding of Data                     .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I ADD_CHILD                     Adds Child (No Duplicates)                                  .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I CHECK_CHILD_ADDITION          Checks Whether Child Can Be Added (Not Duplicated)          .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I GET_CHILDREN                  Provides Children in Metamodel                              .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I GET_PARENTS                   Provides Parents in Metamodel                               .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I GET_TYPE                      Provides Type in Metamodel                                  .
IF_MLCOSTING_MM_NODE           I REMOVE_CHILD                  Removed Child                                               .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I CLOSE_ARCHIVE                 Close Archive File                                          .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_BOM              Read Subcontracting Components                              .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_CD               Read Archived Change Documents for a Document               .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_CONDITION        Read Conditions                                             .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_CONF             Read Confirmations                                          .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_IR               Read Archived Purchasing Info Record                        .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_NAST             Read Archived Messages                                      .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_PARTNER          Read Archived Partners for a Document                       .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_PD               Read Archived Purchasing Document                           .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_PR               Read Archived Purchase Requisition                          .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVED_SRV              Read Service Data for Document                              .
IF_MMPUR_ARCHIVE               I GET_ARCHIVE_HANDLE            Read Archive Handle If Needed                               .
IF_MMPUR_EINM_ORDRSP           I GET_DATA                      Data Transfer                                               .
IF_MMPUR_EINM_ORDRSP           I PROCESS                       Data Processing                                             .
IF_MMPUR_EINM_ORDRSP           I SET_DATA                      Data Transfer                                               .
IF_MMPUR_UI_VENDOR_DATA        I CHECK_AUTHORITY               check authority                                             .
IF_MMPUR_UI_VENDOR_DATA        I GET_CONTACT_PERSONS           get communication data of contact persons                   .
IF_MMPUR_UI_VENDOR_DATA        I GET_VENDOR_DATA               get vendor adress data                                      .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Return the Value of an Attribute, If Single Value           .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Returns Values of an Attribute If Multiple Value            .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_MOFID                     Returns the Unique MOF ID                                   .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_REFERENCE                 Returns the Value of a Reference If Single Value            .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_REFERENCES                Returns Values of the References if Multiple Values         .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I GET_STATE                     Object status                                               .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I IS_MULTI_VALUED_ATTRIBUTE     Attribute is Multiple Value                                 .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I IS_MULTI_VALUED_REFERENCE     Reference Is Multiple Value                                 .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Sets the Value of an Attribute If Single Value              .
IF_MMR_INSTANCE                I SET_REFERENCE                 Sets the Value of a Reference If Single Value               .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I COMMIT                        Commit (Transfer of Changes and Java MMR)                   .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I CREATE_INSTANCE               Creates an Instance                                         .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I FINALIZE                      Clearing Tasks                                              .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I QUERY                         Query (Search) of the MMR (Java)                            .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I READ_INSTANCE                 Reads an Instance from MMR (Java)                           .
IF_MMR_REPOSITORY              I WRITE_TO_MMR                  Writes the Changes to the MMR (Java)                        .
IF_MNT_APO_CONVERT             I CONVERT_R3_DATA_TO_APO        Filters and converts ERP data for APO                       .
IF_MNT_BTE_TRANSFER            I BTE_TRANSFER                  Controls BTE Transfer                                       .
IF_MNT_DELTA_READ              I READ_BY_FILTER                Read orders for delta report                                .
IF_MNT_GET_DATA                I GET_FILTER_OBJ_BY_PLANT       Select all filter objects with plant from given list        .
IF_MNT_GET_DATA                I GET_MAT_WERK_WITH_APOKZ       Get material / plant combinat with noninitial APOKZ in MARC .
IF_MNT_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_DATA                Get order data from database                                .
IF_MNT_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_HEADERS_FROM_FLT_OBJGet order headers from database (by filter object)          .
IF_MNT_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_HEADERS_FROM_KEY    Get order headers from database (by order number)           .
IF_MNT_GET_FILTER_OBJ          I GET_FILTER_OBJECTS            Returns Filter Objects                                      .
IF_MNT_INITIAL_TRANSFER        I INITIAL_TRANSFER              Reads data for initial transfer to APO                      .
IF_MNT_MANAGE_LOG              I ADD_MESSAGE_TO_LOG            Adds Message to CIF Application Log for MPO                 .
IF_MNT_MANAGE_LOG              I APPEND_LOG_TO_CIF_LOG         Appends Content to Generic CIF Log                          .
IF_MNT_MANAGE_LOG              I GET_MESSAGES                  Get messages of CIF log                                     .
IF_MNT_REFRESH_TRANSFER        I REFRESH_TRANSFER              Controls refresh transfer                                   .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I CHECK_OBJECTS                 Checks Whether Two Objects Can Occur in This Relationship   .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I CHECK_OBJECTS_EXT             Extended Object Check                                       .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I GET_PROPERTIES                Returns the Attribute Objects of Relationship               .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I GET_PROPERTY                  Returns a Specific Attribute Object (If Available)          .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I HAS_ROLES                     Checks Whether Two Role Types Fit With Relationship Type    .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I HAS_ROLES_EXT                 Enhanced Role Check                                         .
IF_MODEL_BINREL                I SET_ACTIVE                    Setting Migration Flag                                      .
IF_MODEL_BINREL_PROP           I GET_BRELS                     Relationship Types That Use This Attribute                  .
IF_MODEL_HOLDER_MM             I GET_MODEL                     Returns the Current Model                                   .
IF_MODEL_HOLDER_MM             I SET_MODEL                     Sets Current Model                                          .
IF_MODEL_ROLE                  I GET_BRELS                     Returns Relationship Types That Use This Role               .
IF_MODEL_ROLE                  I GET_OBJECTS                   Returns All Permitted Objects for this Role                 .
IF_MODEL_ROLE                  I IS_ALLOWED_OBJECT             Checks If an Object Is Permitted in this Role               .
IF_MODEL_ROLE                  I IS_IN_BREL                    Checks If Role Appears in a Relationship Type               .
IF_MO_SELECTION_DME            I GET_ALL_OBJECTS               Gets all Instances of an MO Classe                          .
IF_MO_SELECTION_DME            I GET_RELATED_OBJECT            Gets Associated Object                                      .
IF_MO_SELECTION_DME            I GET_RELATED_OBJECTS           Gets the Associated Objects                                 .
IF_MO_TRANSPORT_DME            I APPEND_TRANSPORT_LIST         Adds an Object List to the Transport Object List            .
IF_MO_TRANSPORT_DME            I GET_CHECK_LIST                Gets the Transport Object Liste for the Check Time          .
IF_MO_TRANSPORT_DME            I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Gets the Object List for a Transport Object List            .
IF_MO_TRANSPORT_DME            I GET_TRANSPORT_INFO            Gets the Transport Attributes of a Class                    .
IF_MO_TRANSPORT_DME            I GET_TRANSPORT_LIST            Gets the Transport Object List for an Object List           .
IF_MP_VALIDATION               I VALIDATE_CONDITION_VALUE      Validate Condition Value Entered by User                    .
IF_MP_VALIDATION               I VALIDATE_FIELD_VALUE          Validate Value Entered by User in the Field                 .
IF_MR_API                      I CREATE_FOLDER                 Create Folder in MIME Repository                            .
IF_MR_API                      I DELETE                        Delete MIME Object in the MIME Repository                   .
IF_MR_API                      I FILE_LIST                     Supply All Files of a Folder in the MIME Repository         .
IF_MR_API                      I GET                           Supply Contents of a MIME Object                            .
IF_MR_API                      I GET_API                       Create API Instance                                         .
IF_MR_API                      I GET_IO_FOR_URL                Supply Kpro Object (LOIO) Based on URL Address              .
IF_MR_API                      I PROPERTIES                    Supply Properties of a MIME Object                          .
IF_MR_API                      I PUT                           Create or Overwrite MIME Object in the MIME Repository      .
IF_MR_EXT_FROLE                I SET_DRAGDROP_OBJECT           Drag&Drop Object for Folder Role                            .
IF_MR_EXT_FROLE                I SET_MENU_OBJECT               Menu Object for Folder Role                                 .
IF_MSG_OUTPUT                  I ISSUE                         Displays Message                                            .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I CHANGE_PERSPECTIVE            Triggers a Switch of View                                   .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I CHANGE_PERSPECTIVE_REVIEW     Triggers a Switch of View in Review View                    .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONFIRM_APPR_TABLE        Access to Confirmation Table                                .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONFIRM_KEEP_TABLE        Access to Confirmation Table                                .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONFIRM_REJ_TABLE         Access to Confirmation Table                                .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONTEXT_BEGDA             Gets Start Date of Context                                  .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONTEXT_ENDDA             Gets End Date of Context                                    .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CONTEXT_TABLE             Access to Context Table                                     .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CURRENT_PERSPECTIVE_ID    Gets ID of Current View                                     .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_CURRENT_VIEW              Gets Current View                                           .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_DETAIL_OBJECT             Gets Reference to Single Item Object                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_DETAIL_TABLE              Access to Detail Table                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_DRILL_DOWN_OBJECT         Gets Reference to Drill-Down Object                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_DRILL_DOWN_TABLE          Access to Drill-Down Table                                  .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_F4_PERSPECTIVE            Gets F4 Help for Permitted Views                            .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_F4_REASONS                Gets Rejection Reasons                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_REVIEW_APPR_TABLE         Access to Review Table                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_REVIEW_ERR_TABLE          Access to Review Table                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_REVIEW_KEEP_TABLE         Access to Review Table                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_REVIEW_REJ_TABLE          Access to Review Table                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_SINGLE_ITEM_OBJECT        Gets Reference to Single Item Object                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I GET_SINGLE_ITEM_TABLE         Gets Reference to Single Item Table                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I HANDLE_EVENT                  Application is notified of commands                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Application                                 .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_APPLICATION    I SET_CONTEXT_DATE              Sets New Period for Context                                 .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_COMPRATIVE_VAL I GET_COMPARATIVE_CRITERIEN     Gets Consolidation Criteria for View                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_COMPRATIVE_VAL I GET_COMPARATIVE_VALUE         The comparison values are provided for a consolidation line .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_BADI_CUSTOMIZING          Gets Customizing Required for BAdI                          .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_COMPARISON_INFO           Description of Comparison Columns                           .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_CONSOLIDATION_INFO        Description of Consolidation Criteria                       .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_FIELDLIST_DETAIL          Field Selection for Detail View                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_FIELDLIST_SINGLE          Field Selection for Individual Record View                  .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_MSS_SELECTION_CRITERIA    Gets Selection Criteria for MSS Context                     .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_PERIOD_INFO               Period and First Day of Period                              .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_PERSPECTIVES              ID and Descriptive Text of Permitted Views                  .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_PROCESS_INFO              Profile-Dependent Data                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_PROJECT_SELECTION_CRITERIAGets Selection Criteria for Project Context                 .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST           I GET_START_PERSPECTIVE         ID of Initial View                                          .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_BADI_CUSTOMIZING          Gets Customizing for BAdI Call                              .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_CONSOLIDATION_INFO        Gets Consolidation Fields                                   .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_F4_PERSPECTIVE            Gets F4 Help for Perspective                                .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_CONTEXT            Gets Field Selection for Context View                       .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_DETAILS            Gets Field Selection for Detail View                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_DRILL_DOWN         Gets Field Selection for Consolidation View                 .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_REVIEW             Gets Field Selection for Review View                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_REVIEW_ERROR       Gets Field Selection for Review View (Error Table)          .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_REVIEW_REJ         Gets Field Selection for Review View (Rejection Records)    .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_LAYOUT_SINGLE_ITEM        Gets Field Selection for Individual Item View               .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_PERIOD_INFO               Gets Period of Consolidation                                .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_PERSPECTIVE_ID            Gets Current View ID                                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_PROCESS_INFO              Gets General Information About Process                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_CUST_PROCESSOR I GET_SUM_INFO                  Which CATSDB Field To Use for Totaling                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_BWGRL_OUT                 Gets BWGRL in Output Conversion                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_CATSAMOUNT_OUT            Gets CATSAMOUNT in Output Conversion                        .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_CATSDB_EXT                Gets CATSDB_EXT Part of Object                              .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_CATSDB_STATUS             Gets the CATSDB Status                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_CATSHOURS_OUT             Gets CATSHOURS in Output Conversion                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_CATSQUANTITY_OUT          Gets CATSQUANTITY in Output Conversion                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_COUNTER                   Gets the CATSDB Counter                                     .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_INT_STATUS                Gets Buffer Status                                          .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_LONGTEXT                  Gets Long Text for Record                                   .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_OFMNW_OUT                 Gets CATSHOURS in Output Conversion                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_PERNR                     Gets Personnel Number of Record                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_PRICE_OUT                 Gets PRICE in Output Conversion                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_REASON                    Gets Rejection Reason                                       .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_REASON_TEXT               Gets Text for Rejection Reason                              .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_RECID                     Delivers Record ID                                          .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_REFCOUNTER                Gets Counter of Previous Record                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I GET_WORKDATE                  Gets Date of Record                                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I RESET                         Convert Record to Default Status                            .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I SET_APPROVAL                  Record Flagged for Approval                                 .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I SET_KEEP                      Record To Remain Unchanged                                  .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I SET_REASON                    Sets Preliminary Rejection Reason                           .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TIME_RECORD    I SET_REJECTION                 Record To Remain Rejected                                   .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I CHECK                         Locks and Compares the Changed Records                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I CLEANUP                       Unlocks Locked Records                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_CONTEXT_TIME_RECORDS      Gets Working Times for Context                              .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_F4_REJECTION_REASONS      Gets Rejection Reasons                                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_OUT_OF_SYNC_TIME_RECORDS  Gets Working Times Changed on Database                      .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_PREDECESSOR               Gets Working Time for a Ref Counter                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_REVIEWED_APPR_TIME_RECORDSGets Working Times for Review                               .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_REVIEWED_KEEP_TIME_RECORDSGets Working Times for Review                               .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_REVIEWED_REJ_TIME_RECORDS Gets Working Times for Review                               .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_SAVED_APPR_TIME_RECORDS   Gets Working Times That Are Saved                           .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_SAVED_REJ_TIME_RECORDS    Gets Working Times That Are Saved                           .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_TIME_RECORDS              Gets Working Times for Approval                             .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I GET_UNLOCKED_TIME_RECORDS     Gets Working Times with Lock Errors                         .
IF_MSS_CAT_APPR_TR_PROCESSOR   I SAVE                          Saves the Approved/Rejected Records on CATSDB               .
IF_MULTIPLE_ECP                I AUTHORITY                     Authorization Check (No Use Until Now)                      .
IF_MULTIPLE_ECP                I COPY                          Copy Easy Cost Planning                                     .
IF_MULTIPLE_ECP                I DELETE                        Delete Easy Cost Planning                                   .
IF_MULTIPLE_ECP                I MAINTAIN                      Display/Change Easy Cost Planning                           .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I GET_CURRENT_METAFIELD         Active Metafield                                            .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I GET_CURRENT_MODEL             Determine Active Model of Container                         .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I GET_MODELS                    Determine Table of Models                                   .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I GET_SELECTED_MODELS           Determine Selected Models                                   .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I NEXT                          Activate Previous Model                                     .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I PREVIOUS                      Activate Next Model                                         .
IF_MULTIPLE_MODEL_HOLDER_MM    I SET_CURRENT_MODEL             Set Active Model for Container                              .
IF_MYOBJECTS_EXT               I CHANGE_CTXMENU                Change Context Menu                                         .
IF_MYOBJECTS_EXT               I CHANGE_LAYOUT                 Change Layout of Grid                                       .
IF_MYOBJECTS_EXT               I CHANGE_TOOLBAR                Change Toolbar                                              .
IF_MYOBJECTS_EXT               I GET_OUTTAB_AND_FIELDCAT       Transfer Output Table and Field Catalog                     .
IF_MYOBJECTS_EXT               I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           Process User Entries                                        .
IF_MYOBJECTS_MODEL             I DELETE_OBJECTS                Delete Objects                                              .
IF_MYOBJECTS_MODEL             I GET_NODE_TEXT                 Read Node Text                                              .
IF_MYOBJECTS_MODEL             I GET_OBJECTS                   Read Objects                                                .
IF_MYOBJECTS_MODEL             I UPDATE_OBJECTS                Modify objects                                              .
IF_NAVTREE_CUST_VER_ICL        I COMPARE_NODE                  Compare Attributes to See If There Are Any Changes          .
IF_NODE_PII                    I ASSIGN                        Method of Node that Visitor Receives                        .
IF_NWBC_RUNTIME_EXTENSION      I EXT_NAVIGATION_TREE           Allow navigation tree to be updated.                        .
IF_NWBC_RUNTIME_EXTENSION      I EXT_OBN_TARGETS               Support redefinitions of OBN targets.                       .
IF_O2_HTML_PATTERN             I GET_SOURCE_PATTERN            Read Pattern                                                .
IF_O2_SO2_CONVERTER            I CONVERT_EXT_TO_INT            Converts the external souce format to the internal O2 format.
IF_O2_SO2_CONVERTER            I CONVERT_INT_TO_EXT            Converts the internal O2 souce format to the external format.
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I GET_CHILD_NODES               Read Subnodes for a Node                                    .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I GET_INITIAL_TREE_NODES        Return Initial Tree                                         .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Get Root Node of Subtree                                    .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I HANDLE_NODE_CONTEXT_MENU_REQ  Fill Context Menu for Node                                  .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I HANDLE_NODE_CONTEXT_MENU_SEL  Process Function from Context Menu                          .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I HANDLE_NODE_DOUBLE_CLICK      Process Double-Click on Node                                .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I HANDLE_NODE_KEYPRESS          Process Key Pressed on Node                                 .
IF_O2_TAG_TREE                 I HANDLE_NODE_ON_DRAG           Process Drag Event for Node                                 .
IF_OBJECT_CHECKS_DME           I CHECK_ATTRIBUTES              Dispatching the Attribute Checks                            .
IF_OBJECT_CHECKS_DME           I CHECK_FOR_DEL                 Checks whether Object can be Deleted                        .
IF_OBJECT_CHECKS_DME           I CHECK_FOR_INS                 Check whether new Object can be Created                     .
IF_OBJECT_COLLECTION           I GET                           Gets Element                                                .
IF_OBJECT_COLLECTION           I GET_ITERATOR                  Returns an iterator                                         .
IF_OBJECT_COLLECTION           I IS_EMPTY                      Checks whether elements are contained                       .
IF_OBJECT_COLLECTION           I SIZE                          Specifies number of contained elements                      .
IF_OBJECT_ID_FIEB              I GET_CLASS_ID                  Supplies the class ID                                       .
IF_OBJECT_ID_FIEB              I GET_DB_REF                    Supplies the database key                                   .
IF_OBJECT_ID_FIEB              I GET_ID                        Supplies the ID of the persistent object                    .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I CONTAINS_KEY                  Checks whether key is contained                             .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I CONTAINS_VALUE                Checks whether value is contained                           .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET                           Returns a Value to the Key                                  .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_BY_POSITION               Returns the Object at a Specific Position                   .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_KEYS                      Returns all Keys                                            .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_POSITION                  Returns the Position of an Object in the Map                .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_VALUES                    Returns all Values                                          .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_VALUES_ITERATOR           Returns an Iterator for Objects Contained                   .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I GET_VALUES_TABLE              Returns Objects as an Internal Table                        .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I IS_EMPTY                      Checks Whether Map Contains Elements                        .
IF_OBJECT_MAP                  I SIZE                          Returns the Number of Elements Contained                    .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_COSTING_COMPONENTS        Costing Object (Optional)                                   .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_COSTING_GUID              Global Costing Number (Optional)                            .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_COSTING_NUMBER            Cost Estimate Number                                        .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_DATA                      Read Object Information                                     .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_INTERFACE_FOR_CO_OBJECT   Interface for Overhead Application (Optional)               .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_INTERFACE_FOR_DIP         Interface for DIP (Optional)                                .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_INTERFACE_FOR_TEMPLATE    Interface for (Process Costs) Template (Optional)           .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I GET_TYPE                      Reference Object Type                                       .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I ON_COST_ESTIMATE_DELETE       Reset Cost Estimate Pointer/Key when Deleting               .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I ON_COST_ESTIMATE_TMP_SAVE     Set Cost Estimate Pointer/Key when Temporarily Saving       .
IF_OBJECT_OF_COSTING           I UNIT_CONVERSION               Quantity Conversion in Alternative Quantity Unit (Optional) .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I CONVERT_ATTR_VALUE            Attribute Value Input Conversion                            .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I CREATE_ATTR_FIELD             Creates a Data Object for an Attribute Type                 .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I GET_ATTR_TABFIELD             Gets the Table Field for an Attribute                       .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I GET_FOREIGN_KEY_DESCR         Gets the Foreign Key Relationships                          .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I GET_TABLE_TYPE_DESCR          Gets the Table Row Typ Description                          .
IF_OBJ_META_DME                I REFRESH_DDIC_INFO             Refresh Buffered DDIC Information                           .
IF_OBL_OBJTYPE                 I GET_BRELS                     Returns All Relationship Types In Which Object Is Permitted .
IF_OBL_OBJTYPE                 I GET_NOTMIGRATED               Checks If Old Runtime Data Is Relevant for Object Type      .
IF_OBL_OBJTYPE                 I GET_ROLES                     Returns All Roles In Which the Object Is Permitted          .
IF_OBL_OBJTYPE                 I HAS_BREL                      Checks Whether the Object Can Occur in a Related Type       .
IF_OBL_OBJTYPE                 I HAS_ROLE                      Checks Whether the Object Can Occur in the Role Type        .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I APPLY_VARIANT                 Apply Variant To Graphical View                             .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I CHANGE_CLUSTER                Change Cluster                                              .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I CHANGE_LINE                   Change Line                                                 .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Node                                                 .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I COLLAPSE_GROUP                Collapse Group/Cluster                                      .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I CREATE_HEADING                Create Heading                                              .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I CREATE_NODES                  Create Nodes                                                .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DELETE_VARIANT                Delete Variant                                              .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DISPLAY_CLUSTER               Display Cluster                                             .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DISPLAY_LINE                  Display Line                                                .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DISPLAY_NODE                  Display Node                                                .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DOUBLE_CLICK_LINE             Double Click Line                                           .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DOUBLE_CLICK_NODE             Double Click Node                                           .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I DUPLICATE_NODE                Duplicate Node                                              .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I EXPAND_GROUP                  Expand Group/Cluster                                        .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I GROUP_NODES                   Group Nodes Together Into Cluster                           .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I INSERT_LINE                   Insert Line                                                 .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I INSERT_NODE                   Insert Node                                                 .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I REMOVE_ENTITIES               Remove Entities                                             .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I SAVE_GRAPHICS                 Save Graphics                                               .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I SAVE_GRAPHICS_AS_VARIANT      Save Graphics As Variant                                    .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I UNGROUP_NODES                 Ungroup Nodes From Cluster                                  .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I VIEW_SPECIFIC_ACTION          Handle View Specific Actions                                .
IF_OIUGT_GRAPHICAL_VIEW        I VIEW_SPECIFIC_HELP            View Specific Help                                          .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER             I GET_DATA_LOCATION             Data Inline and/or Nearline (Which Instances)               .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER             I POPULATE_LOCAL_REFERENCES     Put Local References Back Into Parser Instance References   .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER_SELECT      I TRAVERSE_HAVING               Traverse Parse Tree for Having Clause                       .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER_UPDATE      I SPLIT_FIELD_IN_SET_CLAUSE     Is Split Field In SET_CLAUSE?                               .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER_UPDATE      I TRAVERSE_SET_CLAUSE           Traverse SET_CLAUSE                                         .
IF_OIUP_SQL_PARSER_WHERE       I TRAVERSE                      Traverse Parse Tree                                         .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I DMS_CONSISTENCY_CHECK         Special Consistency Check Related to DMS Document Links     .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I DMS_GET_DETAIL                Obsolete                                                    .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I GETCONTENT_DOC                File Data of Original for the 'Document' of a Document      .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I GETDETAIL_DOC                 Detailed Data for 'Document' of a Document Info Record      .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I GETDETAIL_FOLDER              Detailed Data for 'Folder' of a Document Info Record        .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I LOAD_DMS_OBJECT_LINKS         Loading via Individual Persistence Admin. of Proxy Class    .
IF_OLR3_DMS_PROXY              I SAVE_DMS_OBJECT_LINKS         Saving via Individual Persistence Admin. of Proxy Class     .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Check Consistency of Linked Object                          .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Existence of Linked Object                            .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I GET_DATA                      Obtain Data of Linked Object                                .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I GET_DATES                     Schedules for cProject Object Link Time Bar                 .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I GET_RPSCO_DATA                RPSCO Data for  cProject Object Link Evaluation             .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I GET_RPSCO_OBJECT              Project Hierarchy Information RPSCO Cost Analysis           .
IF_OLR3_PROXY                  I SEARCH_OBJECTS                Search Help for Linked Object                               .
IF_OMRT_DYNAMICINVOKE          I CALL                          Call a Method                                               .
IF_OMRT_DYNAMICINVOKE          I FREE                          Free This Object                                            .
IF_OMRT_DYNAMICINVOKE          I GET_PROPERTY                  Read an Object Property                                     .
IF_OMRT_DYNAMICINVOKE          I PUT_PROPERTY                  Set an Object Property                                      .
IF_OMRT_DYNAMICINVOKE          I PUT_PROPERTY_REF              Set Property as Reference to an Object                      .
IF_OO_ACCESS_PERMISSION        I ACCESS_FOR_INSERT             Authorization Check for Creating / Locking                  .
IF_OO_ACCESS_PERMISSION        I ACCESS_FOR_MODIFY             Authorization Check for Changing / Locking                  .
IF_OO_ACCESS_PERMISSION        I ACCESS_FOR_SHOW               Authorization Check for Displaying / Locking                .
IF_OO_ACCESS_PERMISSION        I FREE                          Unlock                                                      .
IF_OO_CHECK                    I CHECK_CLASS                   Syntax Check for Class                                      .
IF_OO_CHECK                    I CHECK_CLASS_ADDON             Syntax Check For Extension Class                            .
IF_OO_CHECK                    I CHECK_INTERFACE               Syntax Check for Interface                                  .
IF_OO_CHECKLIST                I ADD_WARNING                   Adds a Warning                                              .
IF_OO_CLASS_INCL_NAMING        I GET_ALL_METHOD_INCLUDES       All Methods with Implementation Includes                    .
IF_OO_CLASS_INCL_NAMING        I GET_INCLUDE_BY_APPENDAGE      Determine Class Include Using Name Appendage (LIMU CINC)    .
IF_OO_CLASS_INCL_NAMING        I GET_INCLUDE_BY_MTDNAME        Implementation Include of a Method (LIMU METH)              .
IF_OO_CLASS_INCL_NAMING        I GET_INCLUDE_BY_SECTION        Get Include Using Section (LIMU CPUB, CPRO, CPRI)           .
IF_OO_CLASS_INCL_NAMING        I GET_MTDNAME_BY_INCLUDE        Method of Corresponding Implementation Includes             .
IF_OO_CLIF_OBSERVER            I CHANGE_TOOL_ACTION            Change Tool Mode                                            .
IF_OO_CLIF_OBSERVER            I MODIFY_CLIF                   Change Object Category                                      .
IF_OO_CLIF_OBSERVER            I REFRESH_TOOL                  Refresh Class Builder Display                               .
IF_OO_CLIF_OBSERVER            I SHOW_CLIF                     Display Object Type                                         .
IF_OO_COMPONENT                I CHANGE                        Change Components in Dialog Box                             .
IF_OO_COMPONENT                I CREATE                        Create Component in Dialog Box                              .
IF_OO_COMPONENT                I DISPLAY                       Display Component in Dialog Box                             .
IF_OO_REFACTORING_DISPLAY      I CLOSE                         Closes the Dialog Box                                       .
IF_OO_REFACTORING_DISPLAY      I DISPLAY                       Creates the Dialog Box with Tree and Toolbar                .
IF_OO_TAB_OBSERVER             I USER_COMMAND                  Input Editing                                               .
IF_OPC_EVENT_HANDLER           I RECEIPT_FINISHED              Notification Receipt Finished                               .
IF_OPC_EVENT_HANDLER           I RECEIVE                       Receive Alarms/Events Notification                          .
IF_OPC_ITEM_HANDLER            I RECEIPT_FINISHED              Notification Receipt Finished                               .
IF_OPC_ITEM_HANDLER            I RECEIVE                       Receive Data Access Notification                            .
IF_OPC_SERVER                  I BROWSE_SERVERS                Get List of All Servers Installed on Computer               .
IF_OPC_SERVER                  I GET_DETAILS                   Get Detailed Information about Server                       .
IF_OPC_SERVER                  I GET_LIST                      Get List of All Servers Defined in Customizing              .
IF_OPC_SERVER                  I PING                          Test Connection (RFC and COM)                               .
IF_OPC_SERVER                  I SHOW_LIST                     Display Server List                                         .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_CUSTOMER_DATA     I CONVERT2STRUCTURE             Service for Converting to Global Structure                  .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_CUSTOMER_DATA     I GET_CUST_DATA                 Customer Data from Appends of VTBFHA for Changes            .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_CUSTOMER_DATA     I SET_CUST_DATA                 Put Back Customer Data from Appends of VTBFHA               .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_DATABIN           I SET_FACILITY                  Set Facility in Databin                                     .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I APPLY_FMOD                    Execute Field Modification for External Screen              .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I APPLY_FMOD_TC                 Execute Field Modification for External Screen (Table Ctrl) .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I GET_CTRL_FIELDMOD             Determine Field Modification for List of Fields             .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I GET_CURSOR                    Confirmation Prompt of Current Cursor Position              .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I GET_REQUIRED_FIELDS           Determine Required Fields                                   .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I SET_CURSOR                    Set Cursor on Certain (Database) Field                      .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I SET_FIELDMOD                  Field Modifications from Application                        .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I SET_FIELDMOD_CONDITIONAL      Set Conditional Field Modifications                         .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_FMOD        I SET_FIELD_RELATION            Define Entry Field and Dependent Fields                     .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_MESSAGE     I SET_MESSAGE                   Set Message in TR-TM Transaction Management                 .
IF_OPEN_TRTM_PROXY_MESSAGE     I SET_MESSAGES                  Set Message in TR-TM Transaction Management                 .
IF_ORA_TOOLS                   I GET_DB_INSTANCE_NAME          Get instance name of the database                           .
IF_ORA_TOOLS                   I GET_DB_STARTUP_TIME           Get the startup time of the database                        .
IF_ORGANIZER_CALL_BACK_APPT    I GET_APPOINTMENTS              Read Additional Appointments for a Time Period              .
IF_OSMW_DYNPRO_WRAPPER         I PAI_CALLBACK                  Callback Method for Evaluating Data Input on the Screen     .
IF_OSMW_DYNPRO_WRAPPER         I PBO_CALLBACK                  Callback Method for Passing Data for Output to the Screen   .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_CHANGED                   Gets Objects with Status 'Changed'                          .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_CREATED                   Gets Objects with Status 'Newly Created'                    .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_DELETED                   Gets Objects with Status 'Deleted'                          .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_LOADED                    Gets Objects with Status 'Loaded'                           .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_NOT_LOADED                Gets Objects with Status 'Unloaded'                         .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of an Object                                    .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I GET_TRANSIENT                 Gets All Transient Objects of the Class                     .
IF_OS_CA_INSTANCE              I SET_STATUS                    Object Services Private: Sets the Status of an Object Set   .
IF_OS_CA_PERSISTENCY           I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_KEY         Reads an Object Using its BWL Key                           .
IF_OS_CA_PERSISTENCY           I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_KEY_TAB     Reads Several Objects Using Their BWL Keys                  .
IF_OS_CA_PERSISTENCY           I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_OID         Reads an Object Using its GUID                              .
IF_OS_CA_PERSISTENCY           I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_OID_TAB     Reads Several Objects Using Their OID (GUID)                .
IF_OS_CA_PERSISTENCY           I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_QUERY       Reads Several Objects by Query                              .
IF_OS_CA_QUERY                 I SET_PREFETCH_BUFFER           Sets Buffer for Preselected Data                            .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I GET_OID_BY_REF                Reads an OID Using an Object Reference                      .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I GET_REF_BY_OID                Reads an Object Reference Using an OID (Shell)              .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I OM_PREPARE_FOR_TOP_TRANSACTIONObject Manager Private: Prepare for Top Transaction         .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I OM_SAVE                       Object Manager Private: Save Object Data                    .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I PREPARE_FOR_TOP_TRANSACTION   Object Services Private: Prepare for Top Transaction        .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I SAVE                          Save Object Data                                            .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE               I SAVE_IN_UPDATE_TASK           Save in Update Task                                         .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_ADD_BKEY                 Add business key to root table                              .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_ADD_OID                  Add OID to root table                                       .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_DELETE_BKEY              Delete business key from root table                         .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_DELETE_OID               Delete OID from root table                                  .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_GET_CLASS_AGENT_BY_BKEY  Read class actor for business key from root table           .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_GET_CLASS_AGENT_BY_OID   Read class actor for OID from root table                    .
IF_OS_CA_SERVICE_INHERITANCE   I ROOT_INITIALIZE               Initialize pointer to class actor from root class           .
IF_OS_CHECK                    I IS_CONSISTENT                 Consistency Check                                           .
IF_OS_CLONE                    I CLONE                         Duplicates the Object                                       .
IF_OS_EXCEPTION_INFO           I CLEAR                         Checks Off Exception as Handled                             .
IF_OS_EXCEPTION_INFO           I GET_CONTEXT_OBJECT            Returns Context Object for ID                               .
IF_OS_EXCEPTION_INFO           I GET_CONTEXT_OBJECT_TAB        Returns Context Object List for ID                          .
IF_OS_EXCEPTION_INFO           I GET_CONTEXT_STRING            Returns Context String for ID                               .
IF_OS_EXCEPTION_INFO           I GET_MESSAGE                   Error Message in System Language                            .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I CREATE_PERSISTENT             Generate a Persistent Object                                .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I CREATE_PERSISTENT_BY_KEY      Generate a Persistent Object with Business Key              .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I CREATE_TRANSIENT              Creates a Transient Object                                  .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I CREATE_TRANSIENT_BY_KEY       Generate a Transient Object Using Business Key              .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I DELETE_PERSISTENT             Deletes a Persistent Object                                 .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I REFRESH_PERSISTENT            Force Object To Refresh When It Is Next Accessed            .
IF_OS_FACTORY                  I RELEASE                       Release Object from Administration                          .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I CREATE_PERSISTENT             Create Persistent Object                                    .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I DELETE_PERSISTENT             Delete Persistent Object                                    .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I GET_ALL_OBJECTS               Gets all Loaded Instances                                   .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I GET_MODIFIED_OBJECTS          Gets all New, Deleted and Changed Instances                 .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I GET_PERSISTENT                Get Persistent Object                                       .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I GET_STATUS                    Gets Object Status                                          .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I OBJECT_TO_RECORD              Gets the Tupel for an Object                                .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I RECORD_TO_OBJECT              Get the Object for a Tupel                                  .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I SET_ALL_LOADED                Sets the Attribute ALL_LOADED                               .
IF_OS_FACTORY_DME              I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Object Status                                      .
IF_OS_GENERATOR                I BUILD_CLASS_AGENT             Generates or Modifies Associated Class Actors               .
IF_OS_GENERATOR                I BUILD_MANAGED_CLASS           Generates or Modifies Manageable Class                      .
IF_OS_GENERATOR                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Gets Attributes of Manageable Class                         .
IF_OS_GENERATOR                I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets Attributes of the Manageable Class                     .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_CHANGED                   Reads All Object With Status 'Changed'                      .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_CREATED                   Reads all Object With Status 'New'                          .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_DELETED                   Reads All Objects with Status 'Deleted'                     .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_LOADED                    Reads All Objects with Status 'loaded'                      .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_NOT_LOADED                Reads All Objects with Status 'unloaded'                    .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I GET_STATUS                    Reads the Status of an Object                               .
IF_OS_INSTANCE_MANAGER         I SET_STATUS                    Object Services Private: Sets the Status of an Object Set   .
IF_OS_INTROSPECTION            I CREATE_DATA_OBJECT            Creates a Data Objet                                        .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I DELETE_PERSISTENT              "" obsolete ""                                             .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_KEY         Reads an Object Using its Key                               .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_KEY_TAB     Reads Several Objects Using Their Keys                      .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_OID         Reads an Object Using its GUID                              .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_OID_TAB     Reads Several Objects Using Their OID (GUID)                .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_PERSISTENT_BY_QUERY       Reads Several Objects by Query                              .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I GET_UPDATE_MODE               OS Private: Reads the Update Mode                           .
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I REGISTER_SAVE_MANAGER_FOR_CA  Registers Manager Instead of Agent for SAVE and PREPARE_T_TA.
IF_OS_PERSISTENCY_MANAGER      I SET_UPDATE_MODE               OS Private: Sets the Update Mode                            .
IF_OS_PM_SERVICE               I GET_OID_BY_REF                Object Services Private: Conversion (Runtime ref. -" OID)   .
IF_OS_PM_SERVICE               I GET_REF_BY_OID                Object Services Private: Conversion (OID -" Runtime Ref. )  .
IF_OS_PM_SERVICE               I PREPARE_FOR_TOP_TRANSACTION   Object Services Private: Prepare for Top Transaction        .
IF_OS_PM_SERVICE               I SAVE                          Object Services Private: Save Object Data                   .
IF_OS_QRY_SERVICE              I GET_ORDER_BY_CLAUSE           Order By Clause of Query                                    .
IF_OS_QRY_SERVICE              I GET_WHERE_CLAUSE              Where Clause of Query                                       .
IF_OS_QRY_SERVICE              I MAP                           Execute O/R Mapping                                         .
IF_OS_QUERY                    I GET_EXPR_FACTORY              Returns Expression Factory                                  .
IF_OS_QUERY                    I PARSE                         Parse Filter and Sorting                                    .
IF_OS_QUERY                    I SET_FILTER_EXPR               Set Filter Expression                                       .
IF_OS_QUERY                    I SET_ORDERING_EXPR             Set Sort Expression                                         .
IF_OS_QUERY                    I SET_PARAMETERS_EXPR           Set Parameter Expression                                    .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_AND_EXPR               Create AND Expression (Filter)                              .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_ISNULL_EXPR            Create IS NULLD Expression (Filter)                         .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_LIKE_EXPR              Create LIKED Expression (Filter)                            .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_NOT_EXPR               Create NOT Expression (Filter)                              .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_OPERATOR_EXPR          Create Operator Expression (Filter)                         .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_ORDERING_EXPR          Create Sort Expression                                      .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_OR_EXPR                Create OR Expression (Filter)                               .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_PARAMETERS_EXPR        Create Parameters Expression                                .
IF_OS_QUERY_EXPR_FACTORY       I CREATE_REF_EXPR               Create Reference Expression (Filter)                        .
IF_OS_QUERY_MANAGER            I CREATE_QUERY                  Create Query Instance                                       .
IF_OS_QUERY_ORDERING_EXPR      I APPEND_ASCENDING              Add attribute by which to sort in ascending order           .
IF_OS_QUERY_ORDERING_EXPR      I APPEND_DESCENDING             Add attribute by which to sort in descending order          .
IF_OS_QUERY_PARAMETERS_EXPR    I APPEND                        Add Parameters                                              .
IF_OS_SERVICE_DME              I CLEAR                         Releases all Loaded Instances                               .
IF_OS_SERVICE_DME              I COMMIT                        End of Transaction                                          .
IF_OS_SERVICE_DME              I RESET                         Resets Internal Data After COMMIT                           .
IF_OS_SERVICE_POC              I DELETE                        Delete From DB                                              .
IF_OS_SERVICE_POC              I DEREGISTER                    De-Registers all Event Handlers                             .
IF_OS_STATE                    I GET                           Object Services Private: Copy State Object                  .
IF_OS_STATE                    I HANDLE_EXCEPTION              Handles Exception After Reading State                       .
IF_OS_STATE                    I INIT                          Initializes Transient Part of Object State                  .
IF_OS_STATE                    I INVALIDATE                    Invalidate Object State                                     .
IF_OS_STATE                    I SET                           Object Services Private: Replace State Object               .
IF_OS_STATE_DME                I INIT                          Initialization of Transient Attribute                       .
IF_OS_TA_SERVICE               I SET_INTERNAL_MODES            Object Services Private: Set Internal Sess. before T Start  .
IF_OS_TA_SERVICE               I SET_SUBTRANSACTION            Object Services Private: Set Subtransaction                 .
IF_OS_TM_SERVICE               I SET_CURRENT_TRANSACTION       Object Services Private: Sets Current Valid Transaction     .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I END                           Ends OO Transaction                                         .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I END_AND_CHAIN                 Ends OO Transaction and Starts New One in Same Context      .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I GET_MODES                     Reads Modes of OO Transaction                               .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I GET_STATUS                    Reads Status of OO Transaction                              .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I REGISTER_CHECK_AGENT          Registers a Consistency Check                               .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I SET_MODE_UNDO_RELEVANT        Sets Mode: "Can Transaction Be Undone or Not"               .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I SET_MODE_UPDATE               Sets Mode for Database Synchronization (Top-Level)          .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I START                         Starts OO Transaction                                       .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I UNDO                          Ends OO Transaction with Rollback                           .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION              I UNDO_AND_CHAIN                Ends OO Trans. with Rollback and Starts New in Same Context .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION_MANAGER      I CREATE_TRANSACTION            Creates a New Transaction Object                            .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION_MANAGER      I GET_CURRENT_TRANSACTION       Passes Current Transaction Object                           .
IF_OS_TRANSACTION_MANAGER      I GET_TOP_TRANSACTION           Passes the Topmost Transaction Object                       .
IF_OS_UNDO_MANAGER             I END_TRANSACTION               Object Services Private: OO Transaction Ended Successfully  .
IF_OS_UNDO_MANAGER             I START_TRANSACTION             Object Services Private. New OO Transaction Started         .
IF_OS_UNDO_MANAGER             I UNDO_TRANSACTION              Object Services Private: Undo OO Transaction                .
IF_OUTPUT_MM                   I OVERVIEW                      Message Overview                                            .
IF_OUTPUT_MM                   I PREVIEW                       Print Preview                                               .
IF_PACKAGE                     I ACTIVATE                      Activate Inactive Package                                   .
IF_PACKAGE                     I ACTIVATE_RECURSIVE            Activate Package Recursively                                .
IF_PACKAGE                     I ADD_INTERFACE                 Add Package Interface                                       .
IF_PACKAGE                     I ADD_PERMISSION_TO_USE         Add a Use Access                                            .
IF_PACKAGE                     I ADD_SUB_PACKAGE               Add Sub-package                                             .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_GET_PACKAGE_DATA         Read Package Data (Mass Access)                             .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_LOAD_LIST_OF_PACKAGES    Load Package List                                           .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_LOAD_MAIN_PACKAGES       Load Main Packages                                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_LOAD_ROOT_PACKAGES       Load Root Packages                                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_LOAD_SELECTED_PACKAGES   Load Selected Packages                                      .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_SAVE                     Save Package List                                           .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_SAVE_RECURSIVE           Save Package List with Sub-Packages (Recursive)             .
IF_PACKAGE                     I BULK_SAVE_SUB_PACKAGES        Save Package List with Drect Sub-Packages                   .
IF_PACKAGE                     I CHECK_PERMISSION_CREATABLE    Check to See if Package Use Access Can Be Created           .
IF_PACKAGE                     I CREATE_NEW_PACKAGE            Generate New Package                                        .
IF_PACKAGE                     I DELETE                        Deleted Package (only Delete from Database after SAVE)      .
IF_PACKAGE                     I DELETE_INTERFACE              Delete Package Interface                                    .
IF_PACKAGE                     I DELETE_RECURSIVE              Delete Package Recursively                                  .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Get All Package Attributes                                  .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_CHANGEABLE                Get Package Modifiability                                   .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_CHANGED                   Read Package Change Indicator                               .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_ELEMENTS                  Returns the elements of the package                         .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_INHERITED_PROJECT         Returns inherited assignment to a cPro project              .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_INHERITS_PERMISSION_TO_USEGet 'Inherit Use Access' Indicator                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_INTERFACES                Get List of Package Interfaces                              .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_ORIGIN_SYSTEM             Determine Original System                                   .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_PACKAGE_NAME              Get Package Name                                            .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_PERMISSIONS_TO_USE        Get Use Access                                              .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_SUB_PACKAGES              Get Sub-Packages                                            .
IF_PACKAGE                     I GET_SUPER_PACKAGE             Get Surrounding Packages                                    .
IF_PACKAGE                     I LOAD_PACKAGE                  Load parcel                                                 .
IF_PACKAGE                     I PREORDER_ITERATOR             Scan Package Tree                                           .
IF_PACKAGE                     I REFRESH                       Refresh Package Data (Where Package Cannot Be Changed)      .
IF_PACKAGE                     I REMOVE_SUB_PACKAGE            Remove Sub-Package                                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I REORDER_SUB_PACKAGES          Change Sub-Package Order                                    .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE                          Save Package                                                .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE_GENERIC                  Generic Save (Packages and Sub-Packages Entered)            .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE_INTERFACES               Save Package Interfaces                                     .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE_PERMISSIONS              Save Package Use Accesses                                   .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE_RECURSIVE                Save Package with All Sub-packages (at All Levels)          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SAVE_SUB_PACKAGES             Save Packages with Direct Sub-Packages                      .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Set All Package Attributes (Sub-Quantity Possible)          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_CHANGEABLE                Set/Reset Package Modifiability                             .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_INHERITS_PERMISSION_TO_USESet 'Inherit Use Access' Indicator                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_MASTER_LANGUAGE           Change original language                                    .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_PERMISSIONS_CHANGEABLE    Set/Reset Use Access Modifiability                          .
IF_PACKAGE                     I SET_SUPER_PACKAGE_NAME        Set Surrounding Package                                     .
IF_PACKAGE                     I UNDO_ALL_CHANGES              Undo Changes to Package (NOTE: Unlocks Object)              .
IF_PACKAGE                     I UNDO_ALL_CHANGES_GENERIC      Undo Changes Generically                                    .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_LIST_OF_PACKAGES    Load Package List                                           .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_LIST_OF_PKG_INTERF  Load List of Package Interfaces                             .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_MAIN_PACKAGES       Load Main Packages                                          .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_ROOT_PACKAGES       Load Root Packages                                          .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_SELECTED_PACKAGES   Load Selected Packages                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I BULK_LOAD_SEL_PKG_INTERF      Load List of Selected Package Interfaces                    .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I CREATE_NEW_PACKAGE            Generate New Package                                        .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I CREATE_NEW_PKG_INTERFACE      Generate New Package Interface                              .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Package API                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I LOAD_PACKAGE                  Load parcel                                                 .
IF_PACKAGE_FACTORY             I LOAD_PACKAGE_INTERFACE        Load Package Interface                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I ADD_ACCESS_CONTROL_ELEMENTS   Add to Access Control List                                  .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I ADD_ELEMENTS                  Add to Interface Elements                                   .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I BULK_LOAD_LIST_OF_PKG_INTERF  Load List of Package Interfaces                             .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I BULK_LOAD_SEL_PKG_INTERF      Load Quantity of Package Interfaces                         .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I CHECK_ELEMENT_ENCLOSURE       Check To See if Interface Element Can Be Added              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I COMBINE_INTERFACE             Combine Two Package Interfaces                              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I COPY_INTERFACE                Duplicate Elements of a Package Interface                   .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I CREATE_NEW_PACKAGE_INTERFACE  Generate New Package Interface                              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I DELETE                        Delete Package Interface (Delete from Database AFTER Save)  .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ACCESS_CONTROL_LIST       Get Access Control List                                     .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Get All Package Interface Attributes                        .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_CHANGEABLE                Get Package Interface Modifiability                         .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_CHANGED                   Read Modifiability Indicator for Package Interface          .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_EFFECTIVE_RELEASE_STATUS  Ascertain Effective Release Status                          .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_EFFECTIVE_TRANSL_STATUS   Ascertain Effective Translation Status                      .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ELEMENTS                  Get Package Interface Elements                              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ELEMENTS_CHANGEABLE       Get Modifiability of Interface Assignments                  .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ELEMENTS_CHANGED          Read Modifiability Indicator of Interface Assignments       .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_INTERFACE_NAME            Get Package Interface Name                                  .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_ORIGIN_SYSTEM             Determine Original System                                   .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_PACKAGE                   Get Package                                                 .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_PACKAGE_NAME              Get Package Name                                            .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I GET_PERMISSIONS_TO_USE        Get Package Use Access                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I LOAD_PACKAGE_INTERFACE        Load Package Interface                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I REFRESH                       Refresh Interface Data (where Data Not Changeable)          .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I REMOVE_ACCESS_CONTROL_ELEMENTSRemove from Access Control List                             .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I REMOVE_ELEMENTS               Remove Interface Element                                    .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SAVE                          Save Package Interface (Access Control List)                .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SAVE_ELEMENTS                 Save Package Interface Elements                             .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SAVE_GENERIC                  Save Package Interface Generically                          .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SET_ACCESS_CONTROL_LIST       Set Access Control List                                     .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Set All Package Interface Attributes (Sub-Quantities Poss.) .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SET_CHANGEABLE                Set Package Interface Modifiability                         .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I SET_ELEMENTS_CHANGEABLE       Set Modifiability for Interface Assignments                 .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I UNDO_ALL_CHANGES              Undo and Unlock All Changes                                 .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE           I UNDO_ALL_CHANGES_GENERIC      Undo and Unlock All Changes Generically                     .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I BULK_CREATE_NEW_ELEMENTS      Create Multiple New Package Interface Elements              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I BULK_LOAD_ELEMENTS            Load Multiple New Package Interface Elements                .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I CREATE_NEW_ELEMENT            Create New Package Interface Element                        .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I DELETE                        Delete Package Interface Element (in Memory Only)           .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I FIND_INTERFACES               Find Container Package Interfaces                           .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Read All Attributes                                         .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_INTERFACE                 Get Associated Package Interface                            .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_NOCHECK_ATTRIBUTE         Read Indicator for Package Check Exception                  .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_SHORT_TEXT                Read Short Description of Development Element               .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_STABILITY_ATTRIBUTE       Read Stability Attribute                                    .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_TABLE_USAGE_RESTRICTION   Read Use Limitations for Tables                             .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I GET_USAGE_RESTRICTION         Read Use Limitations                                        .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I LOAD_ELEMENT                  Load Package Interface Element                              .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I RETURN_PACKAGE_NAME           Get Name of Package in which Interface Element Is Stored    .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I SET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Set All Attributes                                          .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I SET_NOCHECK_ATTRIBUTE         Set Indicator for Package Check Exception                   .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I SET_STABILITY_ATTRIBUTE       Set Stability Attribute                                     .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I SET_TABLE_USAGE_RESTRICTION   Set Use Limitation for Tables                               .
IF_PACKAGE_INTERFACE_ELEMENT   I SET_USAGE_RESTRICTION         Set Use Limitation                                          .
IF_PACKAGE_OBJECT_TYPE_SUPPORT I CHECK_EXIST_BY_GENERIC_KEY    Check: Does Object Exist; Does it Belong to Package         .
IF_PACKAGE_OBJECT_TYPE_SUPPORT I GET_DESCRIPTION_BY_GENERIC_KEYRead Short Description                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_OBJECT_TYPE_SUPPORT I SELECT_BY_GENERIC_KEY         Select List of Objects                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I BULK_LOAD_PERMISSIONS         Load Package Use Access Instances (Bulk Access)             .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I CREATE_NEW_PERMISSION         Create New Package Use Access                               .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I DELETE                        Delete Package Use Access (from Memory Only)                .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I GET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Get All Use Access Data                                     .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I GET_PACKAGE_INTERFACE         Get Associated Package Interface                            .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I GET_PUBLISHER_PACKAGE         Get Publisher Package                                       .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I GET_SEVERITY                  Get Error Severity                                          .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I GET_SUBSCRIBER_PACKAGE        Get Subscriber Package                                      .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I LOAD_PERMISSION               Load Package Use Access Instance                            .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I SET_ALL_ATTRIBUTES            Set All Package Use Access Data                             .
IF_PACKAGE_PERMISSION_TO_USE   I SET_SEVERITY                  Set Error Severity                                          .
IF_PAK_DEV_ELEMENT             I FACTORY                       Create instance                                             .
IF_PAK_DEV_ELEMENT             I GET_NOCHECK                   Read Attribute for Package Check Exception                  .
IF_PAK_DEV_ELEMENT             I GET_STABILITY                 Read Attribute for Release Status                           .
IF_PAK_DEV_ELEMENT             I SET_NOCHECK                   Write Attribute for Package Check Exception                 .
IF_PAK_DEV_ELEMENT             I SET_STABILITY                 Write Attribute for Release Status                          .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I GET_NUMBER_OF_PARAMETERS      Returns Number of Parameters                                .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I GET_TOOL_STATE                Reads Current Tool Settings                                 .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I HIDE_DISPLAY                  Close and Release Display                                   .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I PREPARE_FOR_TERMINATION       Clear Up, Save, Release Resources                           .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I RELOAD_DATA                   Reload Data From Database                                   .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I SET_METHOD                    Set Methods                                                 .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I SET_TOOL_STATE                Set Tool Settings                                           .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I SET_WINDOW                    Set Workbench Window for Display                            .
IF_PARAM_LIST                  I SHOW_PARAMETERS               Display Parameters or Update Display                        .
IF_PARTITION_ITEM_POC          I COPY_FINISH                   Completes Copying and May Trigger New Event                 .
IF_PARTITION_ITEM_POC          I COPY_INFORMATION              Copies all Information of Instance                          .
IF_PARTITION_ITEM_POC          I COPY_INSTANCE                 Copies Instance (Without Information)                       .
IF_PARTITION_ITEM_POC          I IS_REGISTERED                 CHECK: Is Element Registered                                .
IF_PARTITION_ITEM_POC          I REGISTER                      Registers Element in Partition Obtained                     .
IF_PARTNERS_MM                 I GET_DATA                      Get Data                                                    .
IF_PARTNERS_MM                 I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_PARTNER_PPF                 I GET_PARTNER                   Delivers Partner Data                                       .
IF_PARTNER_PPF                 I GET_ZAV_ADDRESS               Delivers Address from Central Address Management            .
IF_PARTNER_TRD                 I CLS_GET_PARTNER               Partner Singleton                                           .
IF_PARTNER_TRD                 I GET_CHANGES                   Inform Partner about Changed Business Transactions          .
IF_PARTNER_TRD                 I INITIALIZE                    Set Partner at Initial Value                                .
IF_PAYMENT_ADD_INFO_FOR_GTS    I ADD_INFO_FOR_GTS              Adapt Data for SAP GTS Check                                .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I CLEAN_UP                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I ELEM_TABLE_ADD_NODES          Add Visible Elements                                        .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I ELEM_TABLE_CHANGE_NODES       Change Visible Elements                                     .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I ELEM_TABLE_DELETE_NODES       Remove Visible Elements                                     .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I ELEM_TABLE_SET_NODES          Transfer Visible Elements to Tree                           .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I GET_CURSOR                    Query Cursor Position                                       .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I GET_ELEMS_TO_DROP             Get Drag&Drop Objects (+ Delete)                            .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I GET_ELEM_TYPE                 Get and Reset Type of Chosen Element                        .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I GET_OK_CODE                   Get and Reset OK_CODES                                      .
IF_PB_ELEM_TREE                I SET_MODE                      Set Mode: Display, Change                                   .
IF_PB_PACK_TREE                I REFRESH                       Updates Tree Display                                        .
IF_PB_PACK_TREE                I RESTORE_STATE                 Restores the Saved Tree Status                              .
IF_PB_PACK_TREE                I SET_PACKAGE                   Sets current package in tree                                .
IF_PB_PACK_TREE                I STORE_STATE                   Saves current status of tree and releases tree              .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I ADD_DELTA_TABLES              Set Delta Information for a Type                            .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I ADD_NODES                     Dynamic Addition of Nodes to Tree                           .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I CHECK_OBJTYPE_IN_FILTER       Checks Whether Type Is Excluded by Filter                   .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I CLEAR_NODES                   Delete Delta Info for ADD_NOTES                             .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object from Tree                                     .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Execute FORM EXECUTE_FUNCTION                               .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_EVENT_RECEIVER            Supplies Internal Event Receiver Instance to the Tree       .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_FILTER_STATE              Get Filter State                                            .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_INSTANCE                  Supplies Singleton to Browser                               .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_INST_DATA                 Get Data Record for Instance                                .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_OBJECT                    Get Object Instance from Local Browser Objects              .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Get Selection for Current Tree                              .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I GET_TREE_STRUCTURE            Get Tree_structure for Event Handling of Tree               .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_CONTROLLER      I SET_FILTER_TABLES             Set Filter Tables in Browser                                .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I CHANGE                        Change object                                               .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I DISPLAY                       Display Object                                              .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_FACTORY_METHOD            Get Factory Object for Object Type                          .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_HANDLE                    Get Handle for Current Instance                             .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_KEY                       Get Key                                                     .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_RELATION                  Get and Display a Defined Dependency                        .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_RELATIONS                 Get and Display Dependency                                  .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT          I GET_TREE_INFORMATIONS         Get PDM_TREE and PDM_* Data                                 .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT_FACTORY  I CHECK_OBJECT_EXISTENCE        Check Whether an Object Already Exists                      .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT_FACTORY  I CREATE_INSTANCE               Create Object and Add to Management                         .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT_FACTORY  I GET_HANDLE_FROM_INSTANCE      Get Handle for Current Instance                             .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT_FACTORY  I GET_INSTANCE_FROM_HANDLE      Get Object for Handle                                       .
IF_PDM_BROWSER_OBJECT_FACTORY  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Buffer                                    .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I CREATE_EXISTING               Generates a new instance with the OID transferred           .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I CREATE_OID                    Generates the object OID                                    .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I DB_DELETE                     Deletes the object from the database                        .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I DB_INSERT                     Adds the object to the database                             .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I DB_LOAD                       Fills the object with values from the database              .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I DB_UPDATE                     Modifies the object in the database                         .
IF_PERSISTENT_OBJECT_FIEB      I GET_OID                       Supplies the object OID                                     .
IF_PERSONALIZE_BCS             I GET_PERSONALIZE_MODE          Personalization Type: 0 = No, 1 = Recipient-Dep., 2 = Full  .
IF_PERSONALIZE_BCS             I PERSONALIZE                   Personalization                                             .
IF_PERS_EVENT_HANDLER          I SET_HANDLER                   Event handler initialization                                .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I GET_DATA_XML                  Get personalization data                                    .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I ROLE_COPY                     Copy activity groups                                        .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I ROLE_DELETE                   Delete activity group                                       .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I ROLE_DIALOG                   Display role dialog                                         .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I ROLE_TRANSPORT                Tranport role data                                          .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I SAVE_BUFFER                   Save buffer                                                 .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I SET_DATA_XML                  Set personalization data                                    .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I SYSTEM_DIALOG                 Display system dialog                                       .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I SYSTEM_TRANSPORT              Tranport system data                                        .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I USER_COPY                     Copy user                                                   .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I USER_DELETE                   Delete user                                                 .
IF_PERS_EXTERNAL_TABLE         I USER_DIALOG                   Display user dialog                                         .
IF_PHTMLB_EVENTS               I COMBOBOX_SELECT               "phtmlb:comboBox" onSelect                                  .
IF_PHTMLB_EVENTS               I CONTAINERIB_FUNCTIONSTATUS    "phtmlb:containerIconButton" onClick                        .
IF_PHTMLB_EVENTS               I POPUPMENU_SELECT              "phtmlb:popupMenu" onSelect                                 .
IF_PHTMLB_EVENTS               I SELECTABLELINKBAR_SELECTED    "phtmlb:selectableLinkBar" onItemSelected                   .
IF_PHTMLB_EVENTS               I TRISTATECHECKBOX_CLICK        "phtmlb:tristateCheckbox" onClick                           .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I GET_CHANNEL_TABLE             Gets a Table of Delivery Channels                           .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I GET_CHANNEL_TABLE_ENTRY       Gets nth Channel Table Entry (default: n = 1)               .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I GET_DELIVERY_CHANNEL          Gets Delivery Channel (Result of Physical Routing)          .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I GET_ENDPOINT                  Gets End Point of Delivery Channel                          .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I GET_NUMBER_OF_CHANNELS        Gets the Number of Determined Delivery Channels             .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I SET_CHANNEL_TABLE             Sets the Table of Delivery Channels                         .
IF_PHYROU_XMS_PROP             I SET_DELIVERY_CHANNEL          Sets a Delivery Channel for an Anonymous Business System    .
IF_PLANNING_FREE_BUSY_READER   I GET_MEETING_TIMES             Determines Appointment                                      .
IF_PLANNING_FREE_BUSY_READER   I READ_FREE_BUSY_DATA           Read Free/Busy Data                                         .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I AUDITED_OBJECTS_CHANGED       Audit Objects Were Changed                                  .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I CALCULATE                     Valuation of Investigation (Result from Assessor)           .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I CHECK_RELEASE                 Check Whether Investigation Can Be Released                 .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I DERIVE_PROC_STATUS            Derivation of Processing State from Status                  .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I EXECUTE_ACTION                Execution of an Activity                                    .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Reads Attributes                                            .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DATA_COLLECTOR_CLASSNAME  Return Class Name of Data Collector                         .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DATA_WITHOUT_INSTANTIATIONRead Data w/o Instantiating the Objects                     .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DEFAULT_FILTER_NAME       Name of Filter Class                                        .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DEFAULT_FORM_NAME         Name of Reference Form for Object                           .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DEFAULT_TEXT_IDS          Pass of Text IDs for Investigation                          .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Reads Properties of Attributes                              .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_GUID_OF_QUEST_COPY        Read GUID of Copy of a List Item                            .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_ICON                      Return of Icon for Object                                   .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_TEXT          Return of Text for Object                                   .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_PRIMARY_STATUS            Reading of Status with Lowest Item and Highest Priority     .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_STATUS_4_ACTIVITY         Determine Relevant Status for Transaction Check             .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_STATUS_OPERATION_CATEGORY Scheduling of Status Transaction                            .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I HANDLE_ACTION_CLOSING         Reaction to Completion of an Action                         .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I HANDLE_QUEST_ASSESSM_CHANGING Reaction to Change in Valuation of an Audit Question        .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I IMPORT_AUDITED_OBJECT         Create/Change Audit Object Using UI Table                   .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I IS_CONFIRMABLE                Can the Audit be Confirmed?                                 .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I IS_EXTENSIBLE_FOR_QUESTIONS   Can Unplanned Questions be Added to the Audit?              .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I MAP_INTERNAL_2_EXTERNAL       Converts Internal Hierarchical Data Structure to External   .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Sets Attributes                                             .
IF_PLM_ASSESSMENT_ASSIGNMENT   I SET_GUID_OF_QUEST_COPY        Transfer of GUID to Copy of a List Item                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ASSIGNMENT_DATA   I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Read Attributes (CGPL and Application Data)                 .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ASSIGNMENT_DATA   I GET_DEFAULT_ROLES             Transfer of Default Roles                                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ASSIGNMENT_DATA   I SET_UPDATED_ATTRIBUTES        Updates The Changed Attributes While Saving                 .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I AUTHORITY_CHECK_ACTIVITY      Authorization Check for an Activity in Audit Processing     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I AUTHORITY_CHECK_OBJECT        Check Authorization Object                                  .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I AUTHORITY_CHECK_STATUSACTIVITYAuthorization Check for a Status Activity                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_CHA_ACTIVITY_BY_OBJ       Read Activity for Changing an Object Type                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_CRE_ACTIVITY_BY_OBJ       Read Activity for Creating an Object Type                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_DEL_ACTIVITY_BY_OBJ       Read Activity for Deleting an Object Type                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_DIS_ACTIVITY_BY_OBJ       Read Activity for Displaying an Object Type                 .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_DOC_A_ACTIVITY_BY_OBJ     Read Activity for Assigning a Doc. for an Object Type       .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FILTER            I ACCEPT_NODE                   Use Filter Conditions on Current Node                       .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FILTER            I GET_CRITERIA                  Method of Accessing Filter Conditions (Reading)             .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FILTER            I SET_CRITERIA                  Method of Accessing Filter Conditions (Writing)             .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_APPLICATION_TYPE          Method of Accessing Application Type (Reading)              .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_CAPTION                   Access Method for Meaning (Short Text) (Reading)            .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_INSTANCE                  Access Method for Instance (Singleton) (Reading)            .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_NAME                      Access Method for Form Name (Reading)                       .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Access Method for Object Type (Reading)                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I GET_OPTIONS                   Access Method for Options (Reading)                         .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I HAS_OPTIONS                   Does Form Have Options?                                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I IS_DEFAULT                    Is Default Indicator Set?                                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I SET_DEFAULT                   Access Method for Default Indicator (Writing)               .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_FORM_MODEL        I SET_OPTIONS                   Access Method for Options (Writing)                         .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_HOST              I ACCEPT                        Method of Node that Visitor Receives                        .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I CURRENT_ITEM                  Returns Current Element                                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I FILTER                        Sets Iterator Filter                                        .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I FIRST                         Sets Iterator to First Element                              .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I IS_DONE                       Check: Is Iteration Completed?                              .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I LAST                          Sets Iterator to Last Element                               .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I NEXT                          Sets Iterator to Next Element                               .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR          I ROOT                          Sets Root of Iterator / Initialization of Iterator          .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR_ELEMENT  I CREATE_ITERATOR               Creation of an Iterator                                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_ITERATOR_ELEMENT  I CREATE_ITERATOR_FILTERED      Creation of an Iterator (With Filter)                       .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI       I CALL_UPDATE_BADI              Call of BAdI for Check While Saving (Event: AT SAVE)        .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI       I GET_GUID                      Read of GUID                                                .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI       I GET_PROC_MODE                 Read of Processing Mode                                     .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI_CNTRL I CONVERT_NODE                  Conversion for Any Hierarchy Node                           .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI_CNTRL I EXECUTE_CHANGE_CHECK          Execute Check When Changing (During Save)                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI_CNTRL I EXECUTE_CREATE_CHECK          Execute Check When Creating (During Save)                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI_CNTRL I EXECUTE_DELETE_CHECK          Execute Check When Deleting (During Save)                   .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_UPDATE_BADI_CNTRL I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_VISUALIZE         I CAST_VIEW_CHANGED             Sends VIEW_CHANGED Event                                    .
IF_PLM_AUDIT_VISUALIZE         I IS_FCODE_VALID                Checks Whether Function Code Is Valid                       .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Forward or Execute Function                                 .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I GET_INACTIVE_FUNCTIONS        Determine Inactive Functions                                .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I ON_COPY                       Handling of Copy and Paste in Tree                          .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I ON_MOVE                       Handling of Drag and Drop in Tree or Cut and Paste          .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I ON_WORKLIST_ITEM_REQUESTED    Add One Object to Worklist/Templates                        .
IF_PLM_AUD_APPLICATION         I SAVE                          Save Additional Data                                        .
IF_PLM_PDN_WUI_OBJPAGE         I GET_ID_FIELDS                 Output Identifying Data for Page                            .
IF_PLM_PDN_WUI_OBJPAGE         I GET_WORKFLOW_DATA             Reference to Workflow Data                                  .
IF_PLSRV_SUPPORT_DETAILS       I GET_SUPPORT_DETAILS           Support Details                                             .
IF_PLSRV_SUPPORT_DETAILS       I SET_SUPPORT_MODE              Set Test Mode                                               .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_CLASS                   Check: Checks the Existence of a Class                      .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_CSTIC                   Check: Checks the Existence of a Characteristic             .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_FUNCTION                Check: Checks the Existence of a Variant Function           .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_MATERIAL                Check: Checks the Existence of a Material                   .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_OBJECT                  Check: Checks the Existence of an Object (Material, ...)    .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_TABLE                   Check: Checks the Existence of a Variant Table              .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I CHECK_VALUE                   Check: Checks the Existence of a Value                      .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_CSTIC_VALUE               Get: Reads the Value of a Characteristic                    .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_CSTIC_VALUES              Get: Reads the Value of a Characteristic                    .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_FUNCTION_CSTICS           Get: Reads the Characteristics of a Variant Function        .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_FUNCTION_KEY_FIELDS       Get: Reads the Key Fields of a Variant Function             .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_OBJECT_CSTIC              Get: Reads the Char. of an Object (Class, Material, ..)     .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_TABLE_CSTICS              Get: Reads the Characteristics of a Variant Table           .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_C  I GET_TABLE_KEY_FIELDS          Get: Reads the Key Fields of a Variant Table                .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_CLASSES                   Help Context: Classes                                       .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_CLASS_TYPES               Help Context: Class Types                                   .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_FUNCTIONS                 Help Context: Variant Functions                             .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_MATERIALS                 Help Context: Materials                                     .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_NUM_CSTICS                Help Context: Numeric Characteristics                       .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_OBJECT_TYPES              Help Context: Object Types                                  .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_SYM_CSTICS                Help Context: Symbolic Characteristics                      .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_TABLES                    Help Context: Variant Tables                                .
IF_PMEVC_DEPENDENCY_CONTEXT_H  I GET_VALUES                    Help Context: Values                                        .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_DOC            I GET_DOCUMENT                  returns document associated with this object.               .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_DOC            I SET_DOCUMENT                  sets document association for this object.                  .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I CONFIRM_SAVE                  Bestätigt das Speichern eines Objektes                      .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_CHANGE_NUMBER             Liefert die Änderungsnummer                                 .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_DATE                      Liefert das Änderungsdatum des Objektes                     .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Liefert Beschreibung des Objektes                           .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_KEY                       Liefert Schlüssel des Objektes                              .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_LABEL                     Liefert Label für UI                                        .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_MNT_OBJECT                Liefert das Pflegeobjekt einer Entity                       .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I GET_TYPE                      Liefert den Typ des Objektes                                .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_CHANGED                    Objekt geändert                                             .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_CHANGE_NUMBER_REQUIRED     Prüft, ob eine Änderungsnummer erforderlich ist             .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_CREATED                    Objekte neu angelegt                                        .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_DELETED                    Objekt gelöscht                                             .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_FULLY_LOADED               Objekt vollständig geladen                                  .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I IS_OPENED_FOR_CHANGE          Objekt zum Ändern geöffnet                                  .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I OPEN_FOR_CHANGE               Objekt zum Ändern öffnen                                    .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I OPEN_FOR_READ                 Objekt zum Lesen öffnen                                     .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I SET_CHANGED_FLAG              Setzt Änderungs-Flag                                        .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I SET_DELETED_FLAG              Set Deleted Flag                                            .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I SET_DESCRIPTION               Setzt Beschreibung des Objektes                             .
IF_PMEVC_ENGINE_ENTITY         I SET_MNT_OBJECT                Setzt das Pflegeobjekt einer Engine Entity                  .
IF_PMEVC_PARSER                I COMPLETE_AT_POSITION          Complete Object to Insert in Item in Source Text            .
IF_PMEVC_PARSER                I GET_TOKEN_HELP                F4 Help for Item in Source Text                             .
IF_PMEVC_PARSER                I INIT                          Initialize / New Context                                    .
IF_PMEVC_PARSER                I SYNTAX_CHECK                  Syntax Check                                                .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I COMMIT                        Save current status to database                             .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I CREATE                        Create the object                                           .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I DELETE                        Delete object                                               .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status Object                                          .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I MODIFY                        Change Object                                               .
IF_POA_DEMO_BUSINESS_OBJECT    I ROLLBACK                      Reject Unsaved Changes                                      .
IF_POA_DEMO_STATUS             I DO_STATUS_TRANSITION          Initiate status transfer completely automatically           .
IF_POA_DEMO_STATUS             I GET_ALLOWED_ACTIONS           Query list of permitted actions                             .
IF_POA_DEMO_STATUS             I GET_STATUS_BY_NAME            Query value of a status variable                            .
IF_POA_DEMO_STATUS             I IS_ACTION_ALLOWED             Query whether given action may be executed                  .
IF_POA_DEMO_STATUS             I SET_STATUS_BY_NAME            Set single status variable explicitly                       .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I ADD_OTHER_POLICIES            Update Claim for Changes in Policy Snapshot                 .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I APPLY_CHANGES_TO_CLAIM        Update Claim for Changes in Policy Snapshot                 .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CHECK_DATA                    Check policy data for consistency                           .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CHECK_UNCOMMITTED             Check uncommitted data                                      .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CHECK_UNCO_PARTOCC            Check uncommitted data                                      .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CHECK_VERSION                 Checks a version for internal consistency                   .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CLAIMASSIGN_SET               Sets Memory CLAIMASSIGN                                     .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CLAIM_CLAIMTYPE_CHECK         Check (and change?) the claim internal claim type           .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I CLEAR                         Clear Memory                                                .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I COMMIT_CHANGES                Applies the policy changes to the claim                     .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I COMMIT_CHANGES_PARTICPANT     Applies the policy changes to the claim                     .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I COMPLETE_DATA                 Fill in GUI fields in the policy data                       .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I COPY_CONTENT                  Copy content of another pol data obejct                     .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I NEXT_FREE_POLVNR              Get the highest policy version plus one                     .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I POLM_DB2SCR                   Convert DB Structure to Screen                              .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I POLM_MEM_UPDATE               Fill in GUI Fields of ICL_POLM_EXT Structure                .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I POL_VER_HEADER_CHECK          Check policy header                                         .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I PRIVLG_SET                    Sets Memory of Special Rights                               .
IF_POLS_DATA_ICL               I VERSION_OVERLAP_CHECK         Check to see if the time period overlaps any existing vers  .
IF_POPUP_CALLER_POC            I RECEIVE_POPUP_RESULT          Transfer Return Value                                       .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_BOOK_VALUE                Determine Book Value                                        .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_BUSINESS_TANSACTIONS      Determines Bus. Transactions on Key Date (get_key_date)     .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_BUSINESS_TANSACTION_DATA  Flows of a Business Transaction for this Position           .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_CURRENCIES                Gets Position Currency and Local Currency                   .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_KEY_DATE                  Key Date                                                    .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_MESSAGES                  Get Messages for this Position                              .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_PORTFOLIO                 Gets Portfolio Containing the Position                      .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_POSITION_CATEGORY         Category of Position: Trading, Settlement, Primary Period   .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_POSITION_IDENTIFIER       Determines Position Key                                     .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_POSTING_ITEMS             Table of Posting Items                                      .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_POS_MAN_PROC              Determines Position Management Procedure for this Position  .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_PRODUCT_CLASS             Gets the Product Type and Product Category                  .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_QUANTITY                  Item Quantity                                               .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_SETTLEMENT_DATE           Position Value Date of Transaction or Key Date              .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_SIMULATED_BOOK_VALUE      Determine Simulated Book Value                              .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_STATE                     Gets the Status of the Security Position (Active/Inactive)  .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_TRADING_DATE              Gets the Contract Date                                      .
IF_POSITION_CORE_TRR           I GET_TRANSACTION_NUMBER        Number of Transaction, if Position is in Trading Period     .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I CHECK_LOTS                    Checks Lots for Short Position                              .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I CHECK_QUANTITY                Checks for Short Position                                   .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I CHECK_SHORT_OK                Checks if Short Position Permissible                        .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I DELETE_FLOWS_FOR_TRANSACTION  Deletes all Position Flows for Business Transaction         .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I DELETE_LOTS_FOR_TRANSACTION   Deletes all Lots for Business Trans. (only aut. Lot Pos.)   .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I DELETE_RULE_FOR_FLOWGROUP     Deletes Assignment Rule for Flow Group (aut. Lot Pos. only) .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I DELETE_SUBTOTALS              Deletes Transaction Figures                                 .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_DIFF_TEXT                Returns Differentiations as Text                            .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_DIFF_VALUES              Returns Differentiations                                    .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_NOMINAL_CURR             Gets Nominal Currency                                       .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_OID                      Gets OID Using Object Reference                             .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_POSITION_CAT             Returns Single or Collective Positions                      .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_QUANTITY_CAT             Gets the Quantity Category                                  .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_QUANTITY_FOR_BUSTRANS    Gets the Quantity for a Given Business Transaction          .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_QUANTITY_FOR_DATE        Gets the Quantity for a Given Date                          .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_SELECTOR                 Gets the Position Selector                                  .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_TAB_LOTS_FOR_POSITION    Gets Table with Related Lots                                .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_TAB_LOT_PARTITIONS       Returns Lot Partitions                                      .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I GETU_TAB_POSITION_FLOWS       Returns Table with Position Flows                           .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I INITIALIZE                    Loads the Transient Attributes                              .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I SETU_NOMINAL_CURR             Sets the Nominal Currency                                   .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I SETU_QUANTITY_CAT             Sets the Quantity Category                                  .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I SETU_SELECTOR                 Sets the Position Selector                                  .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I SUPPLEMENT_TRANSACTIONS       Supplements Business Transactions to be Processed           .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I UPDATE_BUSTRANS_FOR_COLLECT   Updates the Business Transaction                            .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I UPDATE_DATE_FOR_CHECK         Updates the Date for Short Position Check                   .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I UPDATE_FLOWS                  The Flows for the Position are Updated                      .
IF_POSITION_TRQ                I UPDATE_LOTS                   The Lots for the Position are Updated                       .
IF_POSITION_TRR                I GET_POSITION_DATA             Get Position Data                                           .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_ACTIONS                   define action meta data  for represented object type        .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_ACTION_CONF               define an action confirmation message                       .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_DETAIL_COMP               object-detail WD comp., implementing  IFC_POWL_DETAIL       .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_FIELD_CATALOG             define field catalog meta data                              .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_OBJECTS                   data retrieval for represented object type                  .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_OBJECT_DEFINITION         define data structure for represented object type           .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I GET_SEL_CRITERIA              define selection criteria meta data                         .
IF_POWL_FEEDER                 I HANDLE_ACTION                 handle actions for object type (c.f. GET_ACTIONS)           .
IF_POWL_INFOSET_QUERY_ENHANCE  I BEFORE_POWL_OUTPUT            Method is called from within IF_POWL_FEEDER~GET_OBJECTS     .
IF_POWL_OVS                    I HANDLE_PHASE_0                Phase 0 (OVS config, c.f. IF_WD_OVS-"set_configuration( ))  .
IF_POWL_OVS                    I HANDLE_PHASE_1                Phase 1 (initialize fields, c.f. set_input_structure( ))    .
IF_POWL_OVS                    I HANDLE_PHASE_2                Phase 2 (search, c.f. query_parameters, set_output_table( )).
IF_POWL_OVS                    I HANDLE_PHASE_3                Phase 3 (set return value, c.f. selection)                  .
IF_PPECHK_CNTL                 I CONSISTENCY_CHECK             Application-Specific Consistency Checks                     .
IF_PPEFIATTR_CNTL              I FILTER_NODE                   Filters Node According To Filter Settings                   .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I MAP_CHILD_NODE_GET            Gets Lower-Level Node (Single-Level)                        .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I MAP_INIT                      Resets Internal Buffer                                      .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I MAP_NODE_ADD                  Adds Node to Mapping Structure                              .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I MAP_PARENT_NODE_GET           Gets Parent Node                                            .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I MAP_ROOT_NODE_GET             Gets Root Node for Tree                                     .
IF_PPEGIARCH_MAP               I UNIQUE_ID_GET                 Gets Unique ID for Tree                                     .
IF_PPEGIARCH_XXX               I INIT                          Initialize Application Tree                                 .
IF_PPEGIARCH_XXX               I NODE_SELECTED_GET             Gets Selected Tree                                          .
IF_PPEGIARCH_XXX               I TREE_DISPLAY                  Displays Application Tree                                   .
IF_PPEGIARCH_XXX               I TREE_REMOVE                   Removes Application Tree from Display                       .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CD_DISPLAY_CLB                Callback for Changing Document                              .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CHANGE_NUMBER_CLB             Callback for Setting/Changing ECN                           .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CMPID_REC_CHECK_CLB           Callback for Recursiveness Check by CMPID                   .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CMP_ASSY_TEMP_CLB             Callback for Setting the Assembly Structure                 .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CMP_ASSY_TEMP_SINGLE_CLB      Callback for Setting the Assembly Structure                 .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I COLOR_CODE_CLB                Callback for Color COde                                     .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I CTMENU_ASSIGLIST_CB           Do application lists need to be offered in the context menu .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I DMU_ATTRIBUTES_SET            Callback for Graphical Attributes in DMU Tool               .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I DMU_OBJ_DELETE_CLB            Callback to automatically remove an object from the viewer  .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I DMU_OKCODE_CLB                Callback for OK Codes for DMU Functions                     .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I EXTERNAL_BROWSER_START_CLB    Callback to Start the External Browser                      .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I FILTER_ACTIVE_CLB             Callback to see if filter is active                         .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I FILTER_READ_CLB               Callback to read the filter                                 .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I FILTER_SET_CLB                Callback to set the filter                                  .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I GUI_STATUS_SET_CLB            Callback to set the GUI status                              .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I GUI_TITLE_SET_CLB             Callback to set the GUI title                               .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I MODELMIX_CLB                  Callback for model mix maintenance                          .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I OKCODE_CLB                    Callback for own OK codes                                   .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I PPE_DISTRIBUTION_CLB          Callback for iPPE distribution                              .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I PRODVER_CLB                   Callback for maintenance of production version              .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I PS_INTERFACE_CLB              Callback for PS interface                                   .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I SAVE_CLB                      Callback to save                                            .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I STATUS_COCKPIT_CLB            Callback for status cockpit                                 .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I STRUCTURE_COMP_CLB            Callback to compare the structures                          .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I STRUCTURE_COPY_CLB            Callback to copy the structure                              .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I STRUCTURE_OPERATION_CLB       Callback for the structure operations                       .
IF_PPEGUIENG_CNTL              I TIME_ANALYSIS_CLB             Callback for the time analysis                              .
IF_PPEGUIREL_CNTL              I PRELID_DELETE                 Delete a PRELID Record                                      .
IF_PPEGUIREL_CNTL              I PRELID_MAINT                  Create/Change a PRELID Record                               .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_BACKUP         Store Buffer Content of TL-Specific Additional Data         .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_BEFORE_SAVE    Go to Task List Types before Saving                         .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_REFRESH        Delete Buffer Content                                       .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_RESTORE        Reset Buffer                                                .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_SAVE           Saver Buffer Content in Database                            .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_SAVE_DEPENDENT Save Dependent Data                                         .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_BUFFER_SYNC           Synchronize Buffer of Task List Type with Database          .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_CONSISTENCY_CHECK     Check Entire Process Structure                              .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PAMDC      Check of Secondary Resources of a Mode                      .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PAMDD      Check of Attributes of a Mode                               .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PNACT      Check Attributes of an Activity                             .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PNACTHD    Check Attributes of Routing Header                          .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PNACTOPR   Check Operation Attributes                                  .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PRIOC      Check Attributes of an Assignment                           .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PRSEQ      Check Attributes of an Assignment                           .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_PRSEQ2     Check Additional Attributes of Relationship                 .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_DATA_CHECK_SPECI      Check Attributes of Specific Data Record                    .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_PRELID_CHECK          Check PRELID Record Using the Application Object            .
IF_PPELIACT_PLAN_CNTL          I LI_PLAN_STRUCTURE_CHECK       Check Buffer Content Before Saving                          .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I AFTER_SAVE                    Goto External Object After Saving                           .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_BACKUP                 Backup the Buffer Tables                                    .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_REFRESH                Refresh/reset the Buffer Table                              .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_RESTORE                Restore the Buffer Table                                    .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_SAVE                   Save Buffer Tables                                          .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_SAVE_DEPENDENT         Save Dependent Data                                         .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I BUFFER_SYNC                   Synchronisation of Buffer for Dependent Data of iPPE Object .
IF_PPELIEXT_CNTL               I DBOP_READ                     Read Update Indicator of the External Data for the Object   .
IF_PPELIEXT_CONTEXT            I CONTEXT_ASSIGN                Assign an iPPE Object to the Context                        .
IF_PPELIEXT_CONTEXT            I CONTEXT_CHECK                 Checks Whether an iPPE Object Can Be Assigned               .
IF_PPELIEXT_CONTEXT            I CONTEXT_FILTER                Filter a Number of Relationships According to the Context   .
IF_PPELIEXT_CONTEXT            I CONTEXT_READ                  Read the Context for an iPPE Object                         .
IF_PPELIEXT_OPERATION          I PXXXID_CHANGE                 External or Internal iPPE Object Changed                    .
IF_PPELIEXT_OPERATION          I PXXXID_CREATE                 External or Internal iPPE Object Created                    .
IF_PPELIEXT_OPERATION          I PXXXID_DELETE                 External or Internal iPPE Object Deleted                    .
IF_PPELIFLO_CCY_FILTER         I CONTAINED                     Checks Whether Comb. of Mat./Plant/SA Should Be Processed   .
IF_PPELIFLO_CMP_FILTER         I CHECK_LOCID_PRVBE_CMPID       Check Against Plant, Supply Area, and Material              .
IF_PPELIFLO_FLO_FILTER         I CHECK_LOCID_PRVBE             Check Against Plant and Supply Area                         .
IF_PPELIFLO_HDR_FILTER         I CHECK_CLASS                   Check Against Class                                         .
IF_PPENIENG_CNTL               I MODE_SET                      Control Graphic Mode (Always When Displayed?)               .
IF_PPENIENG_CNTL               I NODE_ATTRIBUTE_SET            Set the display attributes for nodes from network graphic   .
IF_PPENIENG_CNTL               I REL_ATTRIBUTE_SET             Set the display attributes for relatshps from network graph..
IF_PPENIENG_CNTL               I REL_CREATE                    Application-Specific Creation of Relationships              .
IF_PPEUIARCH_XXX               I ARCHIVE_INDEX_SELECT          Selects Application-Specific Index from Archive             .
IF_PPEXIENG_CNTL               I ECM_EVALUATE                  ECM Evaluation                                              .
IF_PPEXIENG_CNTL               I ECM_INIT                      Initialize ECM                                              .
IF_PPEXIENG_CNTL               I LASTNCHSTAT_EVALUATE          Evaluation of Last 'n' Change Statuses                      .
IF_PPEXIENG_CNTL               I PRODVER_CONTENT_READ          Environment Analysis of a Production Version                .
IF_PPEXIENG_CNTL               I TIMEWINDOWS_EVALUATE          Evaluation of the Change Statuses Within Date Interval      .
IF_PP_PACKAGE_CREATION         I CREATE_NEXT_PACKAGE           Generate Package Templates                                  .
IF_PP_PACKAGE_CREATION         I DELETE_ADD_PACKAGE_DATA       Delete Additional Package Data                              .
IF_PP_PACKAGE_CREATION         I SAVE_ADD_PACKAGE_DATA         Save Additional Package Data                                .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I CONDITIONS_SELECTED           Conditions Selected                                         .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I GET_ICON                      Supplies Icon for Button                                    .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I GET_QUICKINFO                 Supplies Quick Info for Button                              .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Text for Button                                    .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I IS_HEADER_ENABLED             Button Available at Header Level                            .
IF_PRC_ADDITIONAL_BUTTON       I IS_USING_DISPLAY_AREA         Subscreen Area Being Used                                   .
IF_PRC_EXT_CHANGED             I ON_COND_CHANGED               Condition Was Changed                                       .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DATA_SAVE_AFTER               after saving                                                .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DATA_SAVE_BEFORE              before saving                                               .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_CHANGE_AFTER         after changing a document                                   .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_CHANGE_BEFORE        before changing a document                                  .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_CREATE_AFTER         after creating a document                                   .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_CREATE_BEFORE        before creating a document                                  .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_DELETE_AFTER         after deleting a document                                   .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_DELETE_BEFORE        before deleting a document                                  .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_OPEN_AFTER           after opening                                               .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I DOCUMENT_OPEN_BEFORE          before opening                                              .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_CHANGE_AFTER            after changing items                                        .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_CHANGE_BEFORE           before changing items                                       .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_CREATE_AFTER            after creating items                                        .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_CREATE_BEFORE           before creating items                                       .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_DELETE_AFTER            after deleting items                                        .
IF_PRC_SIM_EVENTS              I ITEMS_DELETE_BEFORE           before deleting items                                       .
IF_PRE_PARTNER_PROCESSING_TRG  I PREPROCESS                    Preliminary Step for Processing BTs for Partners            .
IF_PRICAT_CHANGE               I GET_BAPIPARMATEX_KEY          Get Key for Generic BAPI Data                               .
IF_PRICAT_CHANGE               I GET_GENERIC_KEY               Return Object Key for Generic Data                          .
IF_PRJ_APO_CONVERT             I CONVERT_R3_DATA_TO_APO        Filters and converts R/3 data for APO                       .
IF_PRJ_BTE_TRANSFER            I BTE_TRANSFER                  Controls BTE Transfer                                       .
IF_PRJ_DELTA_READ              I READ_BY_FILTER                Read orders for delta report                                .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_FILTER_OBJ_BY_PLANT       Select all filter objects with plant from given list        .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_MAT_WERK_WITH_APOKZ       Get material / plant combinat with noninitial APOKZ in MARC .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_DATA                Get order data from database                                .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_HEADERS_FROM_FLT_OBJGet order headers from database (by filter object)          .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_ORDER_HEADERS_FROM_KEY    Get order headers from database (by order number)           .
IF_PRJ_GET_DATA                I GET_WORK_CENTER_AND_KAKO_DATA Get work center data & KAKO data for given list of  cap reqs.
IF_PRJ_GET_FILTER_OBJ          I GET_FILTER_OBJECTS            Returns Filter Objects                                      .
IF_PRJ_INBOUND                 I UPDATE_NETWORK                Controls Update of Network Sent by APO                      .
IF_PRJ_INITIAL_TRANSFER        I INITIAL_TRANSFER              Reads data for initial transfer to APO                      .
IF_PRJ_MANAGE_LOG              I ADD_MESSAGE_TO_LOG             Adds Message to CIF Application Log for MPO                .
IF_PRJ_MANAGE_LOG              I APPEND_LOG_TO_CIF_LOG          Appends Content to Generic CIF Log                         .
IF_PRJ_MANAGE_LOG              I GET_MESSAGES                  Get messages of CIF log                                     .
IF_PRJ_REFRESH_TRANSFER        I REFRESH_TRANSFER              Controls refresh transfer                                   .
IF_PROC_BEN_TREENODE_ICL       I PROCESS                       Process a benefit tree node                                 .
IF_PROC_NEW_COVTYPE            I PROCESS                       process the next subcltype                                  .
IF_PROC_NEW_SUBCLTYPE          I PROCESS                       process the next subcltype                                  .
IF_PROD_VALUE_RANGE_CAT        I VALUE_RANGE_DELETE            Delete Value Range Limitations at Category/Set Type Level   .
IF_PROD_VALUE_RANGE_CAT        I VALUE_RANGE_MAINTAIN          Maintain Value Range Limitations at Category Level          .
IF_PROD_VALUE_RANGE_CAT        I VALUE_RANGE_READ              Read Value Range Limitations at Category Level              .
IF_PROP_CONTAINER              I GET_TABLE                     Delivers Reference to Internal Tab. for Table Entries       .
IF_PROP_CONTAINER              I GET_VIEW_TABLE                Delivers Reference to Internal Tab. for View Entries        .
IF_PROP_CONTAINER              I GET_VIEW_WA                   Provides Reference to a Work Area for the View Rows         .
IF_PROP_CONTAINER              I GET_WA                        Delivers Reference to Work Area for the Table Rows          .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I ADD_PROTOCOL                  Adds a Protocol of Same Type to Current Protocol            .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I CLONE                         Returns Duplicate Log                                       .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I DISPLAY                       Outputs the Protocol                                        .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I GET_MESSAGES                  Gets the Messages for the Protocol                          .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I HAS_ERRORS                    Protocol Contains Errors                                    .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I HAS_WARNINGS                  Log Contains Warning Messages                               .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I IS_EMPTY                      Protocol has no Entries                                     .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I SET_COMMIT                    Business Transaction in Log Have Been Committed             .
IF_PROTOCOL_TRP                I SET_ROLLBACK                  Business Transactions in Log Have Been Reset                .
IF_PROXY                       I GET_TEXT_FOR_DIRECTION        Get Text for Direction (Inbound/Outbound)                   .
IF_PROXY                       I GET_TEXT_FOR_IFRTYPE          Get Text for IFR Type (ifmmessif, and so on)                .
IF_PROXY                       I GET_TEXT_FOR_MODE             Get Text for Mode (Synchronous/Asynchronous)                .
IF_PROXY                       I GET_TEXT_FOR_R3TYPE           Get Text for R/3 Type (DTEL, TABL, and so on)               .
IF_PROXY_STYLESHEET            I GENERATE                      Generated Stylesheets ( sprox_s_data )                      .
IF_PROXY_STYLESHEET            I GENERATE_EXCEPTION            Generated Stylesheets ( sprox_s_data )                      .
IF_PROXY_STYLESHEET            I GENERATE_INVERSE              Style Sheet Generation Inverse for XML-"ABAP (Only for Test).
IF_PROXY_XML                   I DISPLAY_XML                   Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_PROXY_XML                   I GET_XML_BINARY                Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_PROXY_XML                   I GET_XML_TEXT                  Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_PROXY_XML                   I INIT_WITH_RANDOM_DATA         Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I CHECK_OBJECT_EXISTENCE        Does object for key already exist?                          .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I DISPLAY                       Display                                                     .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I GET_HANDLE_FROM_INSTANCE      Get Handle from Instance                                    .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I GET_INSTANCE_FROM_HANDLE      Get Instance from Handle                                    .
IF_PSB_ADDON_CLASS             I INITIALIZE                    (Re-)Initialization of Class                                .
IF_PTU_FREEABLE_OBJECT         I FREE_DATA                     Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PTU_HAS_UTILITY_OBJECTS     I UPDATE_UTILITIES              Update Help Objects                                         .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_BAPIRET2                  Add a BAPI Return Structure                                 .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_BAPIRET2_TAB              Add a BAPI Return Table                                     .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_EMPTY_LINE                Write an Empty Line                                         .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_LOG                       Add Application Log                                         .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_MESSAGE                   Collection of a Message                                     .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_MESSAGE_COMPLETE          Collection of a Message with All Parameters                 .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_MESSAGE_SIMPLE            Collect Message, Simple Interface                           .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_TEXT                      Insert Text                                                 .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I ADD_TIME_STAMP                Collect Time Stamp with Text                                .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I DISPLAY_LOG                   Display Application Log                                     .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I GET_MOST_SEVERE_MSGTY         Issue Most Grave Message Type                               .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE                 I SET_TRACE_LEVEL               Set Trace Level                                             .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE_N               I ADD_EMPTY_LINE                Write an empty line                                         .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE_N               I ADD_MESSAGE                   Collection of a message                                     .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE_N               I ADD_MESSAGE_SIMPLE            Collect Message, Simple Interface                           .
IF_PTU_MESSAGE_N               I ADD_TIME_STAMP                Collect time stamp with text                                .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I CHANGE_LOG                    Exchange Application Log                                    .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I GET_TIMING                    Output Time Information                                     .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I RESET_TIMING                  Reset Time Information                                      .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I START                         Start Time Measurement                                      .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I STOP                          Stop Time Measurement                                       .
IF_PTU_TIMING                  I WRITE_TIMING                  Log Time Messages                                           .
IF_PT_A2003_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I FINALIZE                      Termination                                                 .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I GET_GUI_LAYOUT                GUI Layout for Next Run                                     .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I GET_ROOT_NODE_ID              Initial Node ID                                             .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Message Processing                                          .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I INITIALIZE                    Late Initialization                                         .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_CORE         I IS_ACTIVE                     Active?                                                     .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_TMW_CORE     I GET_EMPLOYEE_SELECTION_PERIOD Determin Employee Selection Period                          .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_TMW_CORE     I GET_INFOS_FOR_SELID           Dialog Box Settings for Selection ID Definitions            .
IF_PT_APPLICATION_TMW_CORE     I IS_DATA_MODIFIED              Does Changed Data Exist?                                    .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I GET_MOLGA                     Gets the Country Grouping                                   .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I GET_WEBMO                     Gets the WEBMO                                              .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Application                                 .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I INITIALIZE_ACTORS             Initialize Actors                                           .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I SET_ACTORS_TO_REQUEST         Intializes the Request                                      .
IF_PT_ARQ_APPLICATION          I SET_OWNER                     Sets the Owner                                              .
IF_PT_ARQ_ATTABS_TYPE          I GET_NAME                      Gets the Name of the Absence                                .
IF_PT_ARQ_ATTABS_TYPE          I GET_POSSIBLE_ATTABS_TYPES     Gets All Permitted Attendance/Absence Types                 .
IF_PT_ARQ_ATTABS_TYPE          I GET_UNIT                      Delivers Unit                                               .
IF_PT_BLP_PSAVE_HANDLER        I PROCESS_PSAVE                 Performs Activities After Saving                            .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_COL                   Time COL: Collision Check (Type-Specific)                   .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_DEP                   Time DEP: Create Dependencies                               .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_ENR                   Time Point "ENR": Dependent Data Enhancement                .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_NEW                   Time NEW: Default Values                                    .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_PPR                   Time PPR: Pre-Processing                                    .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_RET                   Time RET: Recalculation for Subsequent Program              .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_SAV                   Time SAV: Save Time Data and Follow-Up Activities           .
IF_PT_BLP_TPOINT_COUNTRY       I PROCESS_SRP                   Time SRP: Individual Record Processing                      .
IF_PT_BSF_BSB_FCT_SNGL_RL_STP  I CREATE_BUSUB                  Generation of Business Subject                              .
IF_PT_BSF_BUMOD_FACTORY        I GET_BUMOD_INSTANCE            Gets Module Instance Without Interface Object               .
IF_PT_BSF_BURUL_CONTEXT_PART   I ADD_CONTEXT_PART              Adds Context Part to Business Rule Context                  .
IF_PT_BSF_BURUL_CONTEXT_PART   I REMOVE_CONTEXT_PART           Removes Context Part from Business Rule Context             .
IF_PT_BSF_BURUL_IF_IF          I DO_EXPORT                     Enables Update of Secondary Contexts                        .
IF_PT_BSF_BUSINESS_SUBJECT     I GET_BURUL_ALL                 List of all Business Rules for Business Subject             .
IF_PT_BSF_BUSINESS_SUBJECT     I GET_BURUL_PERS_ASSIGN_DATE    Gets Business Rule Responsible for Pers. Assgmt on Key Date .
IF_PT_BSF_BUSUB_FACTORY        I CREATE_BUSUB                  Generation of Business Subject                              .
IF_PT_BSF_BUSUB_IF_IF          I DO_EXPORT                     Imparts Update to Secondary Contexts                        .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_BUMOD_FACTORY             Gets Instance of Factory for Module Instances               .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_BUMOD_INTERFACE           Delivers Business Rule Module Interface Object              .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_BURUL_CONTAINER           Delivers Business Rule Context Container                    .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_BURUL_INTERFACE           Delivers Business Rule Interface Object                     .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_BUSUB_INTERFACE           Delivers Business Subject Interface Object                  .
IF_PT_BSF_INTERFACE_FACTORY    I GET_CONTEXT_PARTS             Gets Context Elements for Rule Step                         .
IF_PT_BSF_RULE_STEP_STRATEGY   I GET_RULE_STEP                 Which Step Number Is to Be Executed                         .
IF_PT_BSF_RULE_STEP_STRATEGY   I REFRESH_PROCESSED_CONTRACTS   Valid Pers. Assgmts to Be Redetermined?                     .
IF_PT_CONTEXT_CONTAINER        I ADD_CONTEXT                   Inserts Context                                             .
IF_PT_CONTEXT_CONTAINER        I REMOVE_CONTEXT                Deletes Context                                             .
IF_PT_CONTRACT_GROUP_DRIVER_IF I DO_EXPORT                     Export of Changed Data                                      .
IF_PT_CONVERTER_FOR_LOG_TAB    I CONVERT_COMPONENT_INTO_LOG_TABCall Until CX_PT_CONVERT_IF_CMP_EXIT Discarded              .
IF_PT_CONVERTER_FOR_LOG_TAB    I INIT_FOR_INTERFACE_CMP        Initializes Split and Check Whether Table Available         .
IF_PT_CONVERTER_FOR_LOG_TAB    I INIT_FOR_TABLE_NAME           Initializes Split and Check Whether Table Available         .
IF_PT_CUMBT_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_CUST_FIELD_TAB           I GET_FIELD_TAB                 Prepare Table for Fields To Be Selected                     .
IF_PT_DAYMO_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of Changed Data                                      .
IF_PT_DAY_DRIVER_IF            I DO_EXPORT                     Synchronizes Any Contexts Created More Than Once            .
IF_PT_DRIVER_APPLICATION_CORE  I FINALIZE                      Termination                                                 .
IF_PT_DRIVER_APPLICATION_CORE  I GET_ROOT_DRIVER               Delivers the First Driver in the Driver Hierarchy           .
IF_PT_DRIVER_APPLICATION_CORE  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_DRIVER_APPLICATION_CORE  I POST_MESSAGE                  Transfer of Messages to the Drivers                         .
IF_PT_DRIVER_FACTORY           I GET_NEXT_DRIVER               Delivers Next Driver to IM_DRIVER_ID in the Hierarchy       .
IF_PT_DRIVER_FACTORY           I GET_ROOT_DRIVER               Delivers the First Driver in the Driver Hierarchy           .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_CALE                      Returns Personal Calendar of Employee                       .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_ENAME                     Returns Formatted Employee Names                            .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_INFOTYPES                 Read Interface for Time Infotypes of Employee               .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_MOTPR                     Personnel Subarea Groupings for Daily Work Schedule         .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_PWS                       Reads Individual Work Schedules                             .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_RATE                      Gets Collective Agreements for Employee from Infotype 0008  .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_T001P                     Returns T001P Entry Relevant for Key Date                   .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_T503                      Returns T503 Entry Relevant for Key Date                    .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_TIMPAIR                   Returns Time Pairs of Employee                              .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_TIMRES                    Returns Time Evaluation Results                             .
IF_PT_EMPLOYEE                 I GET_WLIST                     Returns List of Time Evaluation Messages                    .
IF_PT_END_DRIVER_IF            I DO_EXPORT                     Exports changed data                                        .
IF_PT_EXECUTABLE               I EXECUTE                       Executes Object                                             .
IF_PT_EXECUTABLE               I GET_INTERFACE                 Delivers the Interface Object of the Executable Object      .
IF_PT_EXECUTABLE               I SET_INTERFACE                 Parameterizes Executable Object with Interface Object       .
IF_PT_GUI_DYNPRO_FIELD         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_GUI_DYNPRO_FIELD         I ON_HELP_REQUEST               Field Help                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_DYNPRO_FIELD         I READ_VALUE                    Read Value                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_FACTORY              I CREATE_OBJECT                 Generate GUI Object                                         .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I ADD_CHILD                     Attach Sublayout                                            .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I CLONE                         Create New Object with Same Class                           .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I DELETE_CHILD                  Delete Sublayout                                            .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I FIND_GUI_LAYOUT               Find GUI_Layout                                             .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I FREE                          Release                                                     .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I GET_LAYOUT_DESCRIPTION        Descriptive Text for Specified Layout ID                    .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I GET_NODE                      GUI Object for Nodes                                        .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I GET_OBJECT                    Navigate to GUI_Objects Included                            .
IF_PT_GUI_LAYOUT               I MAP_GUI_TO_UIA_LAYOUT_ID      Map GUI According to UIA                                    .
IF_PT_GUI_OBJECT               I FREE                          Release                                                     .
IF_PT_GUI_OBJECT               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_GUI_OBJECT               I SHOW                          Display                                                     .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_CONTAINER        I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_CONTROL          I EXPORT_TO_UIA                 Opposite of PAI for Control                                 .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_CONTROL          I INITIALIZE                    Control Initializer                                         .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_CUSTOM_CONTAINER I INITIALIZE                    Initialization for Generic Custom Container                 .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_CUSTOM_TOOLBAR   I INITIALIZE                    Initialization: Connecting to UIA Object                    .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_DOCKINGCONTAINER I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Generic Docking Container                        .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_DYNPRO_FIELD     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_DYNPRO_FIELD     I ON_HELP_REQUEST               Field Help                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_DYNPRO_FIELD     I READ_VALUE                    Read Value                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_SAP_SPLITTER_CONT    I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_CALENDAR         I INITIALIZE                    Special Initialization for Calendar                         .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_NM_GRID          I FREE                          Release                                                     .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_NM_GRID          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_NM_GRID          I SET_LAYOUT                    Set Layout Object                                           .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_NM_GRID          I SET_TOOLBAR                   Set Toolbar Buttons                                         .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_NM_GRID          I SHOW                          Display                                                     .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I ADD_LINE                      Insert Line in Node                                         .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I ADD_NODE                      Create Node in Tree                                         .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I ADD_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Insert Toolbar Buttons                                      .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I CHANGE_ITEM_STATUS            Change Status                                               .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Row                                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I CHANGE_NODE_STATUS            Change Status                                               .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I COLUMN_OPTIMIZE               Optimize Column Width                                       .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I DELETE_ALL_NODES              Delete Tree                                                 .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I DELETE_TOOLBAR                Delete Entire Toolbar                                       .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I EXPAND_ALL_NODES              Expand All Nodes                                            .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I EXPAND_NODES                  Expand Special Nodes                                        .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I FREE                          Exit                                                        .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I FRONTEND_UPDATE               Show Changes                                                .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_CHILDREN                  Get Subnodes (Node Keys)                                    .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Get Current Field Catalog                                   .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_NEW_HIERARCHY             Structure Hierarchy Online                                  .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_NEW_PERIOD                Get New Period in Dialog Box                                .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Get Selected Lines                                          .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I GET_VARIANT                   Get Current Layout                                          .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I SET_FIELDCATALOG              Set New Field Catalog                                       .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I SET_HIERARCHY_HEADER          Set Header Hierarchy                                        .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I SET_SELECTED_NODES            Select Subnodes                                             .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Generate ABAP List Viewer Trees with Global Settings        .
IF_PT_GUI_TMW_TREE_CONTROL     I UPDATE_CALCULATIONS           Calculate Totals                                            .
IF_PT_GWT_IF                   I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_LINKABLE                 I DO_IMPORT                     Transfers the Context to the (Interface) Object             .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_MAINTAIN       I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_MAINTAIN       I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_QUERY          I CHECK_IF_NATIVE               Checks If Interface Name Is Native                          .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_QUERY          I GET_ALL_IFCMPS_FOR_TABNA      Delivers All Interfaces & Attributes for Given Table Name   .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_QUERY          I GET_ALL_NATIVE_IFS            Delivers All Native Interfaces                              .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_QUERY          I GET_CMP_FOR_TABLENAME         Delivers Interface Attributes for Given Table Name          .
IF_PT_NATIVE_IF_QUERY          I GET_CMP_OF_NATIVE_IF          Delivers Usable Attributes from Native Interface            .
IF_PT_P2000_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_P2001_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_P2002_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_P2011_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_P2012_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_P2013_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_PBRKS_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_PCR_INT_MESSAGE_POSTING  I POST_MESSAGE                  Put Message in Queue                                        .
IF_PT_PERIOD_DRIVER_IF         I DO_EXPORT                     Synchronizes Any Contexts Created More Than Once            .
IF_PT_POVT_IF                  I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_PRINT_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_PTIP_IF                  I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_PZL_IF                   I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_QUOTA_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_REQ_APPLICATION          I GET_INITIATOR                 Gets Initiator                                              .
IF_PT_REQ_APPLICATION          I GET_MODUS                     Gets MODUS                                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_APPLICATION          I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Application                                 .
IF_PT_REQ_A_WF                 I CHECK_IF_ABSENT               Checks Whether Actor Sick (Enhancement)                     .
IF_PT_REQ_A_WF                 I GET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Read All Actor Attributes                                   .
IF_PT_REQ_A_WF                 I READ_SUBSTITUTES              Reads Substitutes                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_A_WF                 I SET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Fill All Actor Attributes                                   .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I ADD_ITEM                      Add Request Items                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I CHECK_IF_DEL_REQUEST_PRESENT  Gets Info Whether Only Deletion Request Exists              .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I CHECK_IF_MOD_REQUEST_PRESENT  Gets Info Whether Only Change Request Exists                .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I DETERMINE_REQUEST_OPERATION   Determines Type of Request (New, Canceln, Change Request)   .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ACTOR_ATTRIBS             Gets Actor Attributes                                       .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ADMIN_INFO                Gets Administrative Data                                    .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Gets All Attributes of the Request                          .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_INITIATOR                 Reads Request Owner                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ITEM_LIST                 Gets List of Request Items                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ITEM_LIST_OBJECT_TAB      Gets List of Request Items                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_ITEM_SELECTOR_TAB         Gets Table of Selector Instances                            .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_NEXT_PROCESSOR            Reads Next Processor of Request                             .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_NOTICE                    Gets Note for Request                                       .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_OWNER                     Gets Owner of Request                                       .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_REQUEST_ID                Gets Request ID                                             .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_REQ_TYPE_ATTRIBS          Gets Request Type Attributes                                .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Reads Person Responsible for Request                        .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_STATUS                    Gets Request Status                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_VERSION_NUMBER            Gets Request Version                                        .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I GET_WORKITEM_ID               Read Work Item ID                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Sets All Request Attributes                                 .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_INITIATOR                 Sets the Request Initiator                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_ITEM_LIST_OBJECT_TAB      Sets List of Request Items                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_NEXT_PROCESSOR            Sets Next Agent for Request                                 .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_NOTICE                    Sets Note for Request                                       .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_OWNER                     Sets Request Owner                                          .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_RESPONSIBLE               Sets Person Responsible for Request                         .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_STATUS                    Sets Request Status                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_HEADER               I SET_WORKITEM_ID               Set Work Item ID                                            .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM                 I COMPARE_DB_TO_OBJECT          Compares Database with Object                               .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM                 I GET_ALL_ITEM_ATTRIBS          Gets All Attributes of Request Item                         .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM                 I GET_ITEM_ID                   Gets the Request Item ID                                    .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM                 I SET_ALL_ITEM_ATTRIBS          Sets All Attributes of Request Item                         .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM                 I SET_ITEM_ID                   Sets Request Item ID                                        .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM_SELECTOR        I GET_ITEM_OBJECTS_BY_ID        Get the Request Item                                        .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM_SELECTOR        I GET_ITEM_OPERATION            Determine Operation of Request Item                         .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM_SELECTOR        I ITEM_AGENT_GET                Gets the Class Actor of the Item                            .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM_SELECTOR        I SEL_ITEM_IDS_BY_SELCRIT       Selection of Request Items                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_ITEM_WF              I SET_ALL_ITEM_WF_ATTRIBS       Fill All Workflow Attributes of Items                       .
IF_PT_REQ_MESSAGE_HANDLER      I ADD_MESSAGE                   Add Message                                                 .
IF_PT_REQ_MESSAGE_HANDLER      I FREE_MESSAGES                 Delete All Messages                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_MESSAGE_HANDLER      I GET_MESSAGES                  Display Messages                                            .
IF_PT_REQ_MESSAGE_HANDLER      I INSTANCE_GET                  Get Single Instance                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_PROCESSOR            I CHECK_REQUEST                 Check Request                                               .
IF_PT_REQ_PROCESSOR            I COPY_DATA_TO_PERSISTENT       Make Additional Data Persistent                             .
IF_PT_REQ_PROCESSOR            I GET_WF_MAIN_TASK              Determine Workflow Identifier                               .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I ADD_ITEM                      Add Request Items                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I DELETE                        Delete Request                                              .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Get Request Attributes of Work Area Version                 .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_ALL_ATTRIBS_FOR_ALL_VERS  Get Request Attributes of All Request Versions              .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_CURRENT_VERSION_NO        Determine Current Version of Request                        .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_INITIATOR                 Determine Initiator                                         .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_NEXT_PROCESSOR            Determine Next Agent                                        .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_NOTICE                    Read Note for Request                                       .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_OWNER                     Determine Owner                                             .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Determine Person Responsible                                .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_STATUS                    Determine status                                            .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I GET_WORKAREA_VERSION          Read Work Version                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I INITIATE_STATE_TRANSITION     Initiate Status Transition                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_ALL_ATTRIBS               Set Request Attributes                                      .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_INITIATOR                 Set Initiator                                               .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_NEXT_PROCESSOR            Set Next Agent                                              .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_NOTICE                    Write Note for Request                                      .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_OWNER                     Set Owner                                                   .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_RESPONSIBLE               Set Person Responsible                                      .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_VERSION                   Set Version of Request                                      .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I SET_WORKAREA_VERSION          Set Work Version                                            .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I START_TRANSACTION             Start Transaction                                           .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I VALIDATE_AND_SIMULATE         Check and Simulate Request                                  .
IF_PT_REQ_REQUEST              I WITHDRAW                      Withdraw request                                            .
IF_PT_RPCALC_APPL_CORE_COMM    I GET_APPLICATION_CONTEXT       Delivers Application Context                                .
IF_PT_RPCALC_APPL_CORE_COMM    I SET_LOG                       Transfers Reference to Log Instance                         .
IF_PT_RPTIME_APPL_CORE_COMM    I GET_APPLICATION_CONTEXT       Delivers the Application Context                            .
IF_PT_RPTIME_APPL_CORE_COMM    I SET_LOG                       Transfers Reference to Log Instance                         .
IF_PT_RPTIME_FALL_BACK         I PROGRAM_IS_LOADED             X = program is loaded                                       .
IF_PT_RPTIME_FALL_BACK         I SYNCHRONIZE_INTERFACE         Synchronizes interface with external programs               .
IF_PT_RPTIME_FALL_BACK         I SYNCHRONIZE_PROGRAM           Synchronizes external program with pers. assignment context .
IF_PT_SCHEMA_DRIVER_FACTORY    I FREE_SCHEMA_DRIVER            Releases Requested Schema Driver Again                      .
IF_PT_SCHEMA_DRIVER_FACTORY    I GET_SCHEMA_DRIVER             Delivers Schema Driver Instances                            .
IF_PT_SORT_IF                  I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I CLEAR_DBVERSION               Resets the ID for Database Version                          .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I CLONE                         Generates Identical Copy of Object                          .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I DESTRUCT                      Remove Internal Dependencies (Destructor)                   .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I GET_DATES                     Get Validity Interval of Time Record                        .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I GET_TIMES                     Get Validity of Times of a Time Record                      .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I RESTORE_CONTENT               Returns the Original Status of the Data Object              .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I SET_DBVERSION                 Sets the ID for the Database Version                        .
IF_PT_TD_BASE                  I SET_READ_ONLY                 Sets Read_Only Attribute of Object                          .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I APPEND_AUTHLEVEL              Add New Authorization Level                                 .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I APPEND_TPOINT                 Add Time Point as Run                                       .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I CHECK_IN                      Buffer Check In                                             .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I CLEAR_AUTHLEVEL               Deles All Authorization Levels                              .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I CLEAR_TPOINT                  Deletes All Processed Times                                 .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I SET_AUTHSTAT                  Sets Status of Authorization Check                          .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I SET_CHNGD                     Sets Object to "Changed = Buffer Update"                    .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I SET_OPERA                     Sets Internal Operation Explicitly for BLP                  .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I SET_PRIM                      Sets PRIM Flag                                              .
IF_PT_TD_BLP                   I SET_PRSTAT                    Sets Authorization Status                                   .
IF_PT_TD_BLPADAPTER            I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Data Object from an BLP Internal Record         .
IF_PT_TD_BLPADAPTER            I INITIALIZE_FROM_TABLE         Mass Initialization from BLP Request Table                  .
IF_PT_TD_BLPADAPTER            I SERIALIZE                     Translates Data Object into BLP Request Format              .
IF_PT_TD_BLPADAPTER            I SERIALIZE_FROM_TABLE          Mass Serialization from Object Table                        .
IF_PT_TD_BLPADAPTER            I SET_DEPENDENCIES              Update the Existing Dependencies                            .
IF_PT_TD_CALE                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_CALE                  I SET_DATA                      Set Day Contents                                            .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I CLONE                         Clone Object                                                .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I CREATE_NEW_DATA               Generats New Blank Data Part (Type Change)                  .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I DELETE                        Delete object                                               .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I DESTRUCT                      Remove Internal Dependencies (Destructor)                   .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I GET_OPERA                     Determine BLP Operation                                     .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I GET_OPERA_DB                  Determine Operation re Database                             .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization with New Data Part                    .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I SET_COMMID                    Sets Command ID for BLP Processing                          .
IF_PT_TD_CONTROL               I SET_SIMULATED                 Sets Object to "Simulated"                                  .
IF_PT_TD_DEDUCTION             I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I GET_ALP                       Returns Different Payment When One Exists                   .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I GET_HEADER                    Returns Infotype Header                                     .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I GET_PRELP                     Returns Infotype Partially Transparent (PRELP)              .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I GET_T582Z                     Returns Relevant Entry from Tabel T582Z                     .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I LOCK                          Lock Infotype Record                                        .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_ACCOUNTING                Write Back Quota Data to Object                             .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_ADDATA                    Sets the Additional Data                                    .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_ALP                       Set Different Payment                                       .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_HEADER                    Set Infotype Header                                         .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_PRELP                     Update Infotype Area                                        .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I SET_TEXT                      Sets Infotype Text                                          .
IF_PT_TD_INFOTYPE              I UNLOCK                        Unlocks Infotype Record                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IOBUFFER              I APPEND                        Add New Record for Processing                               .
IF_PT_TD_IOBUFFER              I APPEND_FROM_TABLE             Add New Records from Table for Processing                   .
IF_PT_TD_IOBUFFER              I EMPTY                         Clear Buffer                                                .
IF_PT_TD_IOBUFFER              I FLUSH                         Processes Buffer Content                                    .
IF_PT_TD_IOBUFFER              I READ                          Read Interface                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT0416                I GET_DEDUCTION                 Import Relevant Quota Deduction                             .
IF_PT_TD_IT0416                I GET_T556U                     Import Compensation Subtype Definition                      .
IF_PT_TD_IT0416                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT0416                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2001                I GET_CALE                      Get Related Entries from Employee Calendar                  .
IF_PT_TD_IT2001                I GET_DEDUCTION                 Get Related Deductions                                      .
IF_PT_TD_IT2001                I GET_T554S                     Read Absence Definition                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2001                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2001                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2002                I GET_CALE                      Get Related Entries from Employee Calendar                  .
IF_PT_TD_IT2002                I GET_DEDUCTION                 Get Related Deductions                                      .
IF_PT_TD_IT2002                I GET_T554S                     Read Absence Definition                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2002                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2002                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2003                I GET_T556                      Read Infotype Definition (Customizing)                      .
IF_PT_TD_IT2003                I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object                                           .
IF_PT_TD_IT2003                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2004                I GET_T557                      Read Customizing for Availability                           .
IF_PT_TD_IT2004                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2004                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2005                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2005                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2006                I GET_DEDUCTION                 Return All Deductions                                       .
IF_PT_TD_IT2006                I GET_T556A                     Get Quota Definition                                        .
IF_PT_TD_IT2006                I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object                                           .
IF_PT_TD_IT2006                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2007                I GET_DEDUCTION                 Return All Deductions                                       .
IF_PT_TD_IT2007                I GET_T556P                     Get Quota Definition                                        .
IF_PT_TD_IT2007                I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object                                           .
IF_PT_TD_IT2007                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2010                I GET_T511                      Get Relevant Entry from T511                                .
IF_PT_TD_IT2010                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2010                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2011                I GET_T705A                     Read Customizing                                            .
IF_PT_TD_IT2011                I INITIALIZE                    Initialize with New Data                                    .
IF_PT_TD_IT2011                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_IT2012                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_IT2012                I SET_DATA                      Update Infotype Content                                     .
IF_PT_TD_ITNNNN                I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization                                       .
IF_PT_TD_PWS                   I INITIALIZE                    Object Initialization                                       .
IF_PT_TD_TIMPAIR               I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_TIMPAIR               I SET_DATA                      Set Data Content                                            .
IF_PT_TD_TIMRES                I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I APPEND                        Add new version                                             .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I DELETE                        Delete Particular Version                                   .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I FREE                          Release Container                                           .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I GET_VERSION                   Read Particular Data Version                                .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_VERSCONT              I UPDATE                        Update of a Particular Version                              .
IF_PT_TD_WLIST                 I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_TD_WLIST                 I SET_DATA                      Refresh Data                                                .
IF_PT_TIME_EVALUATION_LOG      I ADD_LOG                       Additional Log                                              .
IF_PT_TIME_EVALUATION_LOG      I SHOW                          Display Log                                                 .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_APER_TO_LOG_BASIC      Sets Period/Daily Node in Log Tree                          .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_FORM                   HR_PL_APPEND_FORM (Append Form)                             .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_MESSAGE                HR_PL_APPEND_MESSAGE (Message to MESSAGE_PTEXT)             .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_PLOG_TEXT              HR_PL_APPEND_PLOG_TEXT (Append to I_LOG_DAT)                .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_PTEXT                  Inserts Lines in Log                                        .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I APPEND_SCHEMA_TO_LOG_BASIC    Sets Schema for Log Tree                                    .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I BOPER_LOG                     Logging Operations                                          .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I CLOSE_LOG_FOR_MOD_PROC        OUTPUT Log After Module and End ACTION                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I COL_ERROR4                    Application Exception (Corresponds to error_status = 2)     .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I COL_ERROR5                    Application Info Without Terminating Driver                 .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I COL_ERRORN                    Appl. Exception/Info with/without Cancel Dependent on MESTY .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I DISPLAY_LOG                   HR_PL_SET_STATUS                                            .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I FILL_LOCAL_LOG_DAT            perfom t_fill_local_log_dat (as_manange_function)           .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I FILL_LOG_KEYS                 Supplies Key in Log                                         .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I FILL_MODIF_IN_LOG             HR_PL_FILL_MODIF_IN_LOG (Supplies Time Management Modifs)   .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I GET_TEXT_IN_CASE_OF_MISSING_GRGets Detailed Text for Missing Rule Group                   .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I INITIALIZE_CE                 Sets CE Switch in HRPL                                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSAGE_CREATE                New Entry in Log                                            .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSAGE_TRANSFER              New Entry in Log                                            .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSG                         Writes P1 at P2 Position to Text P3                         .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSG_1                       Message Handler (1 Parameter)                               .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSG_2                       Message Handler (2 Parameters)                              .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSG_3                       Message Handler (3 Parameters)                              .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MESSG_4                       Message Handler (4 Parameters)                              .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MOVE_LOG_BASIC_KEY            Outline Information for Entire Log HR_PL_MOVE....           .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I MOVE_SEL_SCREEN_TO_PLOG       Adds Selection Screen Parameter to Log                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I OPEN_LOG_FOR_MOD_PROC         Before Module  INPUT Log and Sets ACTION                    .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I PCR_HEADING_LOG               Logs Personnel Calculation Rule Header                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I REFRESH_FUNCTION_TEXT         HR_PL_.... Resets Old Function Contributions in Log         .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I REFRESH_LOG_TABLES            HR_PL_.... Resets All Log Tables                            .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I SET_AS_NUM_INCREMENT          Sets Sequence Number + 1                                    .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I SET_ERROR_IN_LOG              HR_PL_SET_ERROR_IN_LOG                                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I SET_MODIF_FAILED              Rule group not set in schema                                .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I SET_NAME_IN_LOG               HR_PL_SET_ERROR_IN_LOG                                      .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I SET_STATUS_IN_LOG             HR_PL_SET_STATUS_IN_LOG                                     .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I TRANSPORT_KEY                 HR_PL_TRANSPORT_KEY                                         .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I T_CONNECT_AS_WITH_SCHEMA_TREE Links AS with Schema                                        .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I WRITE_1                       Log Utility (1 Parameter + Level)                           .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I WRITE_2                       Log Utility (2 Parameters + Level)                          .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I WRITE_3                       Log Utility (3 Parameters + Level)                          .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_LOG            I WRITE_4                       Log Utility (4 Parameters + Level)                          .
IF_PT_TIME_EVAL_OPERATION_IF   I DO_EXPORT                     Export of Changed Data                                      .
IF_PT_TIMTP_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Export of changed data                                      .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I GET_END_DATE_OF_LAST_TIME_EVALLast Payroll Day of Last RPTIME00 Run                       .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I GET_RECUID                    Get New Record ID                                           .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I GET_TIME_TYPE_PROPERTIES      Time Type Characteristics from T555A                        .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I GET_WORKLIST_PROCESSING_STATUSGet Status from Message Processing                          .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_ABSENCE_QUOTA            Read Quota Info from Infotype 2006                          .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_ATTENDANCE_QUOTA         Read Quota Info from Infotype 2007                          .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_CUMULATED_TIME_BALANCE   Read Period Balance from Table SALDO in Cluster B2          .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_DAILY_TIME_BALANCE       Read Day Balance from Table ZES in Cluster B2               .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_ENAME                    Read Name for Personnel Number                              .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_FORMER_TIME_EVAL_MESSAGESRead Messages from Table FEHLER in Cluster B2               .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_KOKRS                    Read Cost Center                                            .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_LATEST_TIME_EVAL_MESSAGESRead Messages from Table ERT in Cluster B1                  .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_MASTER_DATA              Read Master Data on Key Date of Next Valid in Interval      .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_PWS                      Reads Personal Work Schedule                                .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_T001P                    Read Modifiers                                              .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_T503                     Read T503 for an Employee                                   .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_TIME_DATA                Read Time Data                                              .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_TIME_RECORD              Read Time Record                                            .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I READ_TIME_WAGE_TYPE           Read Time Wage Type from Table ZL in Cluster B2             .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I WRITE_TIME_DATA               Write Time Data                                             .
IF_PT_TMW_BLOP                 I WRITE_TIME_RECORD             Write Time Record                                           .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I COUNTRY_PROCESSING_NEEDED     Country-Specific Processing Required (Yes/No)               .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_COL                   Time COL: Collision Check (Type-Specific)                   .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_DEP                   Time DEP: Create Dependencies                               .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_NEW                   Time NEW: Default Values                                    .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_PPR                   Time PPR: Pre-Processing                                    .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_RET                   Time RET: Recalculation for Subsequent Program              .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_SAV                   Time SAV: Save Time Data and Follow-Up Activities           .
IF_PT_TMW_BLP_TPOINT           I PROCESS_SRP                   Time SRP: Individual Record Processing                      .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE              I ACKNOWLEDGED_BY_USER          User Message Confirmed                                      .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE              I ON_DELETE                     Callback Upon Deleting                                      .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE              I ON_INSERT                     Display Message to User                                     .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE              I SHOWN_TO_USER                 Message Displayed to User                                   .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE_COLLECTION   I CLONE                         Generate New Collection                                     .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE_COLLECTION   I DELETE_MESSAGE                Delete Message from Collection                              .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE_COLLECTION   I DELETE_MESSAGES               Delete Messages from Collection                             .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE_COLLECTION   I INSERT_MESSAGE                Insert Message in Collection                                .
IF_PT_TMW_MESSAGE_COLLECTION   I INSERT_MESSAGES               Insert Messages in Collection                               .
IF_PT_TYPES_IF                 I DO_EXPORT                     Exports Changed Data                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_FACTORY              I COPY                          Copy Factory                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_FACTORY              I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create Object                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_FIELD_INFO                Field Info                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_LABEL                     Medium-Length Description                                   .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_LONG_LABEL                Long Description                                            .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_SHORT_LABEL               Short Description                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_TEXT                      Description                                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_TEXT_FIELD_INFO           Field Info for Text                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_FIELD_DISPLAY        I GET_VALUE                     Value                                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I COPY                          Copy All                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I CREATE_LAYOUT                 Create Layout (Variable Number of Sublayouts)               .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create Object for ID (Variable Number of Subnodes)          .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I FREE                          Release Layout and All Objects                              .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_CHILD_NODES               Get Subordinate Nodes for a Node                            .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_CHILD_OBJECTS             Get Subordinate IDs for a Node                              .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_LAYOUT                    Search for Subordinate Nodes with Layout                    .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_LAYOUT_DESCRIPTION        Descriptive Text for Specified Layout_id                    .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_LAYOUT_ID2                Get Layout ID                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_NODE                      Get Object Reference for a Node ID                          .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_OBJECT                    Get Object Reference for an Object ID                       .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_PARENT_OBJECT             Get Superior Object of Node                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I GET_ROOT_OBJECT2              Get Root Object of Layout                                   .
IF_PT_UIA_LAYOUT               I REFRESH                       Refresh Layout                                              .
IF_PT_UIA_LISTBOX              I GET_LIST                      Returns a List as vrm_values Table                          .
IF_PT_UIA_LISTBOX              I GET_SELECTED_KEY              Returns Selected Key                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_LISTBOX              I SET_SELECTED_KEY              Changes Selection                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I CLONE                         Test Entry                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I COPY                          Copy All                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I FREE                          Release object                                              .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Context menu                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I GET_DYNAMIC_LAYOUT_ID         Get Dynamic Sublayout ID                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Process Message                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_OBJECT               I REFRESH                       Refresh                                                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE          I GET_DATA                      Gets P2001 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE          I SET_DATA                      Sets P2001 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_BALANCE                   Account Status Up To Key Date                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_COMPENSATION              Compensated Up To Key Date                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_DEDUCTION                 Used Up To Key Date                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_ENTITLEMENT               Key Date Entitlement                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_PAYROLL_BALANCE           Calculated (Payroll)                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_PROJECTED_BALANCE         Account Status Including Postings After Key Date            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_PROJECTED_COMPENSATION    Compensated from Key Date                                   .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_PROJECTED_DEDUCTION       Used from Key Date                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ABSENCE_QUOTA    I GET_TYPE                      Quota Type                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I DELETE_APPOINTMENT            Delete appointment                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I GET_TDTYPE_LIST               List with Time Data IDs                                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I PASTE_APPOINTMENT             Paste Appointment                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I PASTE_TDTYPE                  Paste Time Data ID                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I REFRESH_APPOINTMENTS          Refresh Appointments                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_APPT_READER      I UPDATE                        Update Changes to Appointments                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ATTENDANCE       I GET_DATA                      Gets P2002 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ATTENDANCE       I SET_DATA                      Sets P2002 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ATT_QUOTA        I GET_DATA                      Gets P2007 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_ATT_QUOTA        I SET_DATA                      Sets P2007 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_AVAILABILITY     I GET_DATA                      Gets P2004 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_AVAILABILITY     I SET_DATA                      Sets P2004 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I GET_HEADER                    Gets Infotype Header (PSHDR)                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I GET_INFOTYPE_DATA             Gets Infotype Data (PRELP)                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I GET_INFOTYPE_TEXT             Gets Infotype Text (ITTEXT)                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I GET_PSREF                     Gets Account Assignment Info (PSREF)                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I SET_HEADER                    Set Infotype Header (PSHDR)                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I SET_INFOTYPE_DATA             Set Infotype Data (PRELP)                                   .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I SET_INFOTYPE_TEXT             Set Infotype Text (ITTEXT)                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CATEGORY_IT      I SET_PSREF                     Set Account Assignment Info (PSREF)                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CHANGEABLE       I IS_CHANGED                    Query is_changed Indicator                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CHANGEABLE       I IS_DELETED                    Query is_deleted Indicator                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CHANGEABLE       I IS_NEW                        Query is_new Indicator                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CURSOR           I CLEAR_CURSOR                  Delete Cursor Position                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CURSOR           I GET_CURSOR                    Get Cursor Position                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_CURSOR           I SET_CURSOR                    Set Cursor Position                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DATE_SELECTION   I GET_DATE                      Return Time                                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DATE_SELECTION   I GET_DATE_INTERVAL             Return Period                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DATE_SELECTION   I SELECT_DATE                   Set Time                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DATE_SELECTION   I SELECT_DATE_INTERVAL          Set Period                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DEDUCTION        I GET_DEDUCTION                 Deduction Information by Day                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DEDUCTION        I GET_DEDUCTION_SURVEY          Deduction Information: Overview                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_APL       I GET_DATA                      Get APL Data                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_APL       I SET_DATA                      Set APL Data                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_TECH_INFO I GET_ABS_ATT                   Technical Fields for Attendance/Absence                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_TECH_INFO I GET_ATTQUOTA                  Technical Fields for Attendance Quota                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_TECH_INFO I GET_EXTERN_IF                 Technical Fields for External Interface                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DETAIL_TECH_INFO I GET_ITDATA                    Get Technical Fields for Infotype Record                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_DISPLAY_MODE     I SET_DISPLAY_MODE              Display "-" Change                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I ADD_EMPLOYEE                  Insert Employee in List                                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I ADD_SELID                     Insert a New Selection ID from Table                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I CREATE_SELID                  Generate Unique Selection ID                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I DELETE_SELID                  Delete a Selection ID in Table                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I GET_GENERATED_SELIDS          Get Generated Selection ID for Employee                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I GET_GROUP_FOR_SELID           Determine Group for Generated Selection ID                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I GET_INFOS_FOR_SELID           Get Info on Selection ID Definition                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EE_LIST          I GET_SELID_TEXT                Get Current Selection ID                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EMPLOYEE_DISP    I GET_EMPLOYEE                  Personnel Number                                            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_EMPLOYEE_DISP    I GET_NAME                      Name                                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_INFO_SEL         I IS_HEADER_COLLAPSED           Indicates If Header Hidden                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_INFO_SEL         I PROVIDE_CURRENT_INFO_TOPIC    Indicates Selected Info Area                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_INFO_SEL         I PROVIDE_INFO_TOPICS           Gets List of Possible Info Topics                           .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_INFO_SEL         I REFRESH_CURRENT_INFO_TOPIC    Updates Selected Info Area                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU             I GET_NAVIGATION_TOOLBAR        Navigation Toolbar                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU             I GET_NAVIGATION_TREE           Navigation Tree                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU             I GET_TITLE                     Title                                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU_SCENARIO    I GET_NAVIGATION_TOOLBAR        Navigation Toolbar                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU_SCENARIO    I GET_NAVIGATION_TREE           Navigation Tree                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU_SCENARIO    I GET_STATUS                    Status                                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_MENU_SCENARIO    I GET_TITLE                     Title                                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I DELETE_SORT_CRITERIA          Delete User-Specific Sort Criteria                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_CURRENT_PERIOD            Gets Current Period                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_FIELDCATALOG              Field Catalog Describes Data Table Structure (ALV)          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_HIERARCHY_HEADER          Content of Hierarchy Header                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_HTML_HEADER               Get HTML Header (See get_tree_layout)                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_LINES                     Get Data for Display                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_LINES_MARKED              Gets Selected Rows                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_LINE_CTMENU               Structure Context Menu for Row                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_LINE_STATUS               Gets Row Status                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_NODE_CTMENU               Structure Context Menu for Nodes                            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_NODE_STATUS               Gets Node Status                                            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_SORT_CRITERIA             Hierarchy for Displaying Data                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_TMW_CONTEXT               Context to Determine Display Variant (ABAP List Viewer)     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I GET_TREE_LAYOUT               Display One or Several Rows Selection                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I HAS_TREE_CHANGED              Has Tree Changed?                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_CHANGE_HIERARCHY           Hierarchy Change -" Restructure Tree                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_LINE_CTMENU_SELECTED       Select Entry in Context Menu for Row                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_LINE_MARK_CHANGED          Checkbox Selected or Deselected                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_MULTIPLE_LINES_SELECTED    Selection of Several Rows (Double-Click on Node)            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_NODE_CTMENU_SELECTED       Select Entry in Context Menu of Node                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I ON_SINGLE_LINE_SELECTED       Select Individual Row (Double-Click on Row)                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_NAVIGATION_TREE  I SET_NEW_PERIOD                Set New Period                                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_PWS              I GET_DATA                      Gets Personal Work Schedule Data                            .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_RECYCLABLE       I INITIALIZE                    Re-Initialize                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_REMUNERATION     I GET_DATA                      Gets P2010 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_REMUNERATION     I SET_DATA                      Sets P2010 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_SCENARIO_TDE     I GET_ACTIVE_LAYOUT_ID          Get Active Layout ID                                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_STATE_SELECTOR   I ADD_FUNCTIONCODES             Adds New Function Code                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_STATE_SELECTOR   I DELETE_ALL                    Deletes All Function Codes                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_STATE_SELECTOR   I DELETE_FUNCTIONCODES          Delete Function Codes                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_STATE_SELECTOR   I GET_FUNCTIONCODES             Gets Function Codes                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_STATE_SELECTOR   I INITIALIZE                    Sets Current Status                                         .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_SUBSTITUTION     I GET_DATA                      Gets P2003 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_SUBSTITUTION     I SET_DATA                      Sets P2003 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE              I GET_DETAIL                    Returns UIA Layout and Root Object for Details              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE              I GET_LAST_WILL                 Returns Messages for Next Tab Card                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I CHECK_TDTYPE                  Check ID                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I COLLAPSE                      Collapse                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I EXPAND                        Expand                                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I GET_TIMESPEC                  Get Time Data                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_11           I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I CHANGE_VIEW                   Change view                                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I CLEAR_FOCUS                   Deletes the Selection                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I CREATE_APPOINTMENT            Create New Appointment                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I DROP                          Prepare D&D Operation                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I DROP_COMPLETE                 Complete D&D Operation                                      .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_CALENDAR     I SET_FOCUS                     Set Selection                                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_NM           I GET                           Get 1-1 View                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_NM           I GET_CHECKMARKS                Get Permitted Checkboxes                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDE_TE           I GET_TIMEEVENT                 Get Time Event                                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TDTYPE_LIST      I SET_TDTYPE                    TDTYPE selected                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I GET_DATA                      Gets P2011 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I SET_DATA                      Sets P2011 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_BLOP    I DELETE                        Delete Time Entry                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_BLOP    I GET_DATE                      Gets Date from Initialization                               .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_BLOP    I INITIALIZE                    Initializes BLP Time Records                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I FLUSH                         Write Data to the BLP Request Structure                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I GET_DATE                      Get Date                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Get Data to Modify Screen                                   .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I GET_TIMESPEC                  Get General Time Data                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I REFRESH                       Transfer Data from BLP Request Structure                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_DATE                      Set Date                                                    .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_EMPLOYEE                  Set Employee                                                .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_FROM_DETAIL               Transfer Time Data from Other Detail                        .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_RECUID                    Set RECUID                                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_TDTYPE                    Set Short Description                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIMESPEC_DETAIL  I SET_TIMESPEC                  Set General Time Data                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIME_ACCOUNT     I GET_ACCOUNT                   Time Account: Descriptive Text                              .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIME_ACCOUNT     I GET_BALANCE                   Account Balance                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIME_ACCOUNT     I GET_UNIT                      Time Unit (from T006)                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TIME_ACCOUNT     I GET_UNIT_TEXT                 Units Text (from T538A)                                     .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TRANSFER_SPEC    I GET_DATA                      Gets P2012 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_TRANSFER_SPEC    I SET_DATA                      Sets P2012 Data                                             .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_WORKLIST         I GET_WORKLIST                  Time Evaluation Messages with Info                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_WORKLIST         I SET_DATE                      Set Internal Date                                           .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_WORKLIST         I SET_MESSAGE_STATUS            Set Processing Status                                       .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_WORKLIST         I SET_MESSAGE_VISIBILITY        Set Display                                                 .
IF_PT_UIA_TMW_WORKLIST         I SET_SELECTED_MESSAGE_LINE     Select Message Row                                          .
IF_PT_UIA_TOOLBAR              I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Gets All Toolbar Buttons for Navigation Control             .
IF_PT_UIA_TOOLBAR              I ON_FUNCTION_SELECTED          Provides System Function Code to Toolbar Element            .
IF_PT_UIA_TOOLBAR              I ON_TOOLBAR_DROPDOWN           Gets Context Menu for Item                                  .
IF_PT_UIA_TOOLBAR_BUTTON       I GET_BUTTON                    Returns Info on Toolbar Function                            .
IF_PT_UIA_TOOLBAR_BUTTON       I ON_FUNCTION_SELECTED          Select Toolbar Function                                     .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_CLIPBOARD        I CLEAR                         Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_CLIPBOARD        I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_CLIPBOARD        I CUT                           Cut                                                         .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_CLIPBOARD        I PASTE                         Insert                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_CURSOR           I SET_CURSOR                    Set Cursor Position                                         .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I DELETE                        Delete Selected Object                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I FIRST                         Selected Object is First Object                             .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I GET                           Get Selected Object                                         .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I LAST                          Select Last Object                                          .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I NEXT                          Select Next Object                                          .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I PREVIOUS                      Select Previous Object                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DETAIL_ITERATOR  I SET                           Select New Object                                           .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DOMINANT         I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DOMINANT         I CLEAR                         Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DOMINANT         I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DOMINANT         I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_DOMINANT         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_MULTIPLE_MARK    I CLEAR_MARK                    Deselect                                                    .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_MULTIPLE_MARK    I SET_MARK                      Set Selection                                               .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_SCROLL           I CLEAR                         Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_SCROLL           I SET                           Set Data                                                    .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_SINGLE_MARK      I MARK                          Set Selection                                               .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_SINGLE_MARK      I UNMARK                        Deselect                                                    .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I CHECK_TDTYPE                  Check Time Data ID                                          .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I CLEAR                         Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I GET_T001P                     Table Entries for T001P                                     .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I GET_T503                      Table Entries for T503                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMEEVENT        I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMESPEC         I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMESPEC         I CLEAR                         Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMESPEC         I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMESPEC         I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TIMESPEC         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TOPLINE          I CLEAR                         Delete First Line                                           .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_TOPLINE          I SET                           Set First Line                                              .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_WORKSCHEDULE     I CHANGE                        Change                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_WORKSCHEDULE     I CLEAR                         Delete Data                                                 .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_WORKSCHEDULE     I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_WORKSCHEDULE     I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_PT_UIX_TMW_WORKSCHEDULE     I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I GET_DATA                      Get Account Assignment Data                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I GET_ITEM                      Item for Account Assignment                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Account Assignment Data                          .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Account Assignment Data Prior to Validation             .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I INVALIDATE                    Set Account Assignment Invalid (Posting Not Possible)       .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is Account Assignment Persistent?                           .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I IS_VALID                      Account Assignment Error-Free?                              .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ACCOUNT_MM   I SET_DATA                      Set Account Assignment Data (Without Validation)            .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I CREATE_ACCOUNT                Factory Account Assignment                                  .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I CREATE_SCHEDULE               Factory Schedule Line                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_ACCOUNTINGS               Account Assignments                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_CONDITIONS                Get Item Conditions                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_DATA                      Get Item Data                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_FOREIGN_TRADE             Get Foreign Trade Data                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_HEADER                    Document Header for Item                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_HISTORY                   Get PO History                                              .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Item Data                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Item Data Prior to Validation                           .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_SCHEDULES                 Delivery Schedule                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I GET_SHIPPING_DATA             Get Shipping Data                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I INVALIDATE                    Set PO Item Invalid (Posting not Possible)                  .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is PO Item Persistent?                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I IS_VALID                      PO Item Error-Free?                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I SET_CONDITIONS                Set Item Conditions (Without Check)                         .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I SET_DATA                      Set Item Data (Without Check)                               .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I SET_FOREIGN_TRADE             Set Foreign Trade Data (Without Check)                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_ITEM_MM      I SET_SHIPPING_DATA             Set Shipping Data (Without Check)                           .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I CREATE_ITEM                   Factory PO Item                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_CONDITIONS                Get Header Conditions                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_DATA                      Get Header Data                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_FOREIGN_TRADE             Get Foreign Trade Data                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_ITEMS                     Purchase Order Items                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Header Data                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Header Data Prior to Validation                         .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I INVALIDATE                    Set PO Header Invalid (Posting Not Possible)                .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Purchase Order Changeable?                                  .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is PO Header Persistent?                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I IS_VALID                      PO Header Error-Free?                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I SET_CHANGED                   Object is to be Updated                                     .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I SET_CONDITIONS                Set Header Items (Without Check)                            .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I SET_DATA                      Set Header Data (Without Check)                             .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_MM           I SET_FOREIGN_TRADE             Set Foreign Trade Data (Without Check)                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I GET_DATA                      Get Schedule Line Data                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I GET_ITEM                      Item for Schedule Line                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Schedule Line Data                               .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Schedule Line Data Prior to Validation                  .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I INVALIDATE                    Set Schedule Line Invalid (Posting not Possible)            .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is Schedule Line Persistent?                                .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I IS_VALID                      Schedule Line Error-Free?                                   .
IF_PURCHASE_ORDER_SCHEDULE_MM  I SET_DATA                      Set Schedule Line Data (Without Validation)                 .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_DATA                      Read Account Assignment Data                                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_DATAX                     Read X Fields for Account Assignment                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_ITEM                      Read Item Fields for Account Assignment                     .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I IS_PERSITENT                  Account Assignment Data Persistent                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I IS_VALID                      Account Assignment Data Valid                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I SET_DATA                      Set Account Assignment Data                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ACCOUNT_MM     I SET_DATAX                     Set X Fields for Account Assignment                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_BAPI           I GET_DATA                      Read Out Data                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_BAPI           I PROCESS                       Start Program Logic                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_BAPI           I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_FACTORY        I COMMIT                        Trigger Update                                              .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_FACTORY        I CREATE_HEADER                 Create Instance                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_FACTORY        I LOOKUP_HEADER                 Search for Instance                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I CHECK                         Closing Check                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I CLOSE                         Closing Operations                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I CREATE_ITEM                   Create Item with Reference Item                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I CREATE_ITEMS_BY_KEY           Create Items with Reference Document                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_ACTIVITY                  Get Activity Category                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_CONDITION_MANAGER         Deliver Master Condition Manager                            .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_DATA                      Read Header Data: Adjust Interface!                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_DATAX                     Checkbox Structure Header: Adjust Interface!                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_FIREWALL                  Read Firewall                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_IMPORT_DATA               Read Import Data (EIKP)                                     .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_IMPORT_DATAX              Read Checkbox Structure for Import Data                     .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_ITEMS                     Deliver Items                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_PARTNER_MANAGER           Read Partners                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Read Out Persistent Header Data                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_PRICING_MANAGER           Deliver Price Determination Manager                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_REF_DOCUMENT              Read Referenced Document                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_STATE_FOR_RULE            For Internal Use Only! Use GET_DATA                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_TRANSACTION_STATE         For Later Use                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I GET_TRANSACTION_TYPE          Get Transaction Type                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I IS_CONTRACT                   Contract or Scheduling Agreement                            .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I IS_VALID                      Object Valid                                                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I LOOKUP                        Read Item for Key                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I POST                          Save Outline Agreement                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I PROCESS                       Trigger Rule Processing                                     .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_DATA                      Set Header Data: Adjust Interface!                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_DATAX                     Checkbox Structure Header: Adjust Interface!                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_FIREWALL                  Set Firewall                                                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_FIREWALL_CUST             Set Firewall for Customer BAdI                              .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_IMPORT_DATA               Set Import Data (EIKP)                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_IMPORT_DATAX              Set Checkbox Structure for Import Data                      .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_OA_NUMBER                 Set Document Number                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HEADER         I SET_VENDOR_ADDRESS            Set Vendor Address                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HISTORY        I GET_EKBES                     Read EKBES for an Item                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_HISTORY        I GET_RELEASE_DOC               Deliver Release Documentation                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I AVAILABILITY_CHECK            Availability Check                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I CREATE_ACCOUNT                Generate and Add New Account Assignment Object              .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I CREATE_SCHEDULE               Create Delivery Schedule Line                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I DELETE_SCHEDULE               Delete Delivery Schedule Line                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_ACCOUNTS                  Return Account Assignment Objects                           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_ACTIVITY                  Activity of Object                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_CONDITION_MANAGER         Deliver Master Condition Handle                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_DATA                      Read Data                                                   .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_DATAX                     Read X Structure                                            .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_HEADER                    Read Header                                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_HISTORY_MANAGER           Deliver Handler for PO and Release History                  .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_IMPORT_DATA               Read Import Data                                            .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Read Database Status                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_REF_DOCUMENT              Read Referenced Document Item                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_SCHEDULES                 Read Delivery Schedule Lines                                .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I GET_STATE_FOR_RULE            For Internal Use Only! Use GET_DATA                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I IS_VALID                      Valid?                                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I LOOKUP                        Read Schedule Line with Key                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I LOOKUP_ACCOUNT                Determine Account Assignment from Delivery Number           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_CONFIGURATION             Update Configuration                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_DATAX                     Set X Structure                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_DELIVERY_ADDRESS          Set Address Data                                            .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_IMPORT_DATA               Set Import Data                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_IMPORT_DATAX              Checkbox Structure Import Data                              .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_SHIPPING_DATA             Set Shipping Data                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_ITEM           I SET_SHIPPING_DATAX            Set Shipping Data                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I BOM_EXPLOSION                 Start BOM Explosion                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I EDIT_BOM                      Send Component Screen                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_BOM                       Send Component List                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_DATA                      Return Data Structure                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_DATAX                     Return Change Bar                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_ITEM                      Return Item                                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Read Database Status                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I GET_STATE_FOR_RULE            For Internal Use! Use GET_DATA.                             .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I IS_VALID                      Valid Object?                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I SET_DATA                      Set Data Structure                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_OUT_SCHEDULE       I SET_DATAX                     Set Change Bar                                              .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I CHECK                         Final Check                                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I CLOSE                         Closing Operations                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I CREATE_ITEM                   New Item                                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I CREATE_ITEMS_BY_KEY           Generate New Items Using Foreign Key                        .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I GET_ACTIVITY                  Activity of Object                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I GET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I GET_DATAX                     Return Change Bar                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I GET_ITEMS                     Supply Items                                                .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I GET_TRANSACTION_STATE         Transction Status                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I IS_ARCHIVED                   Is document archived?                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I IS_VALID                      Object valid?                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I LOOKUP                        Determine Item Using Item Number                            .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I POST                          Post                                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I PROCESS                       Check All Changed Dependent Objects                         .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I SET_DATA                      Write Data                                                  .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION        I SET_DATAX                     Set Change Bar                                              .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I AVAILABILITY_CHECK            Availability Check                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I BOM_EXPLOSION                 New BOM Explosion                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I EDIT_BOM                      Send Component Screen                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_ACTIVITY                  Activity of Object                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_DATA                      Return Data Structure                                       .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_DATAX                     Return Change Bar                                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Item Data                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Item Data Prior to Validation                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_REQUISITION               Reference to Purchase Requisition (Header)                  .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I GET_SOURCE_OF_SUPPLY          Reference to Source of Supply                               .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I HAS_AUTHORIZATION             Valid Authorization?                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I IS_VALID                      Object Valid?                                               .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I SET_CONFIGURATION             Update configuration                                        .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I SET_DATA                      Set Data Structure                                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQUISITION_ITEM   I SET_DATAX                     Set Change Bar                                              .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_DATA                      Get Account Assignment Data                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_ITEM                      Item for Account Assignment                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_PERSISTENT_DATA           Get Posted Account Assignment Data                          .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I GET_PREVIOUS_DATA             Get Account Assignment Data Prior to Validation             .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I IS_PERSISTENT                 Is Account Assignment Persistent?                           .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I IS_VALID                      Account Assignment Error-Free?                              .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_ACCOUNT_MM     I SET_DATA                      Set Account Assignment Data (Without Validation)            .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_BAPI           I GET_DATA                      Get Purchase Requisition Data                               .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_BAPI           I PROCESS                       Create Purchase Requisition                                 .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_BAPI           I SET_DATA                      Set Purchase Requisition Data                               .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_FACTORY        I COMMIT                        Update                                                      .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_FACTORY        I CREATE_HEADER                 Create Instance                                             .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_FACTORY        I LOOKUP_HEADER                 Search for Instance                                         .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_STATISTICS     I GET_DATA                      Current Purchase Requisition Statistics                     .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_STATISTICS     I GET_DATA_OLD                  Old Purchase Requisition Statistics                         .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_STATISTICS     I RESET_COMPLETION_INDICATOR    Reset "Closed" Indicator                                    .
IF_PURCHASE_REQ_STATISTICS     I SET_COMPLETION_INDICATOR      Close requisition                                           .
IF_PURCHASING_DMS_MM           I GET_ASSIGNMENT                Determine Document Link                                     .
IF_PURCHASING_DMS_MM           I SET_ASSIGNMENT                Change Document Link                                        .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT         I GET_EKKO                      Header Structure                                            .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT         I GET_ITEMS                     Items                                                       .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT         I GET_PARTNERS                  Partners                                                    .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT         I GET_TKOMV                     Conditions                                                  .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT_ITEM    I GET_EKPO                      Item Data                                                   .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT_ITEM    I GET_SCHEDULE_LINES            Delivery Schedule                                           .
IF_PURCHASING_DOCUMENT_SL      I GET_EKET                      Schedule Line Data                                          .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I CHART_CREATE                  Generates Graphic for View                                  .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I DISPLAY                       Displays View At Top of Page                                .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I FREE                          Releases References Again                                   .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I GET_INSTANCES                 Returns All Existing View Manager Instances                 .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I GET_STATUS                    Current Status                                              .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I GET_TABLE_FILTER              Supplies Table Filter Values                                .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Returns Buttons of Toolbar for a View                       .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I GET_VIEWS                     Returns Specific Views                                      .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I HANDLE_CLICK                  Processes Double-Click Event                                .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I HANDLE_EVENT                  Processes Toolbar Button Event                              .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I IMAGE_CREATE                  Generates Screen for a View                                 .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I LEAF                          Scroll                                                      .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I MESSAGE_ADD                   Writes Message to Log                                       .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I MESSAGE_TEXT_ADD              Write Custom Text Message to Log                            .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I REFRESH_VIEW                  Updates Display in View, Data Content Changed               .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I REFRESH_VIEWS                 Updates Display of All Views                                .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I SET_MAX_VIEWS                 Sets the Maximum Number of Views on One Page                .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I TABLE_CREATE                  Creates Table Related to View                               .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I TABLE_DISPLAY                 Displays Table in Modal Dialog Box                          .
IF_QG_EVAL_VIEW_MANAGER        I VIEW_ADD                      Adds a View                                                 .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_IN         I INSPECTION_CANCEL_REQUEST     Request to Cancel an Inspection Lot                         .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_IN         I INSPECTION_CHANGE_REQUEST     Request to Change an Inspection Lot                         .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_IN         I INSPECTION_REQUEST            Request to Create an Inspection Lot                         .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_OUT        I INSPECTION_CANCEL_REQ_CONF    Sending of a Cancellation Confirmation for an Inspection Lot.
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_OUT        I INSPECTION_CHANGE_REQ_CONF    Sending of a Change Confirmation for an Inspection Lot      .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_OUT        I INSPECTION_DECISION_REPLICATONSending of an Inspection Decision for an Inspection Lot     .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_OUT        I INSPECTION_REQ_CONFIRMATION   Sending of a Creation Confirmation for an Inspection Lot    .
IF_QM_COMMUNICATION_OUT        I INSPECTION_STATUS_INFORMATION Sending of the Current Status for an Inspection Lot         .
IF_QRFC_CLIENT_INBOUND         I GET_FAILED_UNIT_BY_QUEUE      Gets First Unit of Queue with Error                         .
IF_QRFC_CLIENT_INBOUND         I GET_QUEUE_STATE               Gets Status of First Unit in Queue                          .
IF_QRFC_CLIENT_OUTBOUND        I GET_FAILED_UNIT_BY_QUEUE      Gets First Unit of Queue with Error                         .
IF_QRFC_CLIENT_OUTBOUND        I GET_QUEUE_STATE               Gets Status of First Unit in Queue                          .
IF_QRFC_LOCK_INBOUND           I LOCK_QUEUE_FROM_CURRENT_POS   Locks Queue After All Inserted Units                        .
IF_QRFC_LOCK_INBOUND           I LOCK_QUEUE_FROM_TOP           Locks Queue Including All Inserted Units                    .
IF_QRFC_LOCK_OUTBOUND          I LOCK_QUEUE_FROM_CURRENT_POS   Locks Queue After All Inserted Units                        .
IF_QRFC_LOCK_OUTBOUND          I LOCK_QUEUE_FROM_TOP           Locks Queue Including All Inserted Units                    .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_INBOUND           I ADD_QUEUE_NAMES_INBOUND       Inserts Unit in Other Inbound Queues                        .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_INBOUND           I ADD_QUEUE_NAME_INBOUND        Inserts Unit in Another Inbound Queue                       .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_INBOUND           I CREATE_UNIT_BY_PATTERN        Generates New Unit with Same Properties                     .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_INBOUND           I GET_QUEUE_NAMES_INBOUND       Gets All Inbound Queues that Contain Unit                   .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTBOUND          I ADD_QUEUE_NAMES_OUTBOUND      Inserts Unit in Other Outbound Queues                       .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTBOUND          I ADD_QUEUE_NAME_OUTBOUND       Inserts Unit in Another Outbound Queue                      .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTBOUND          I CREATE_UNIT_BY_PATTERN        Generates New Unit with Same Properties                     .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTBOUND          I GET_QUEUE_NAMES_OUTBOUND      Gets All Outbound Queues that Contain Unit                  .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I ADD_QUEUE_NAMES_INBOUND       Inserts Unit in Other Inbound Queues                        .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I ADD_QUEUE_NAMES_OUTBOUND      Inserts Unit in Other Outbound Queues                       .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I ADD_QUEUE_NAME_INBOUND        Inserts Unit in Another Inbound Queue                       .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I ADD_QUEUE_NAME_OUTBOUND       Inserts Unit in Another Outbound Queue                      .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I CREATE_UNIT_BY_PATTERN        Generates New Unit with Same Properties                     .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I GET_QUEUE_NAMES_INBOUND       Gets All Inbound Queues that Contain Unit                   .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I GET_QUEUE_NAMES_OUTBOUND      Gets All Outbound Queues that Contain Unit                  .
IF_QRFC_UNIT_OUTINBOUND        I LOCK_AT_INBOUND               Sets Unit Lock on Inbound Side                              .
IF_QUERY_APPLICATION_AREA      I GET_SELECTIONS                Read Application-specific Selection Fields                  .
IF_QUERY_APPLICATION_AREA      I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Application-specific Area                 .
IF_QUERY_APPLICATION_AREA      I SET_SELECTIONS                Fill Application-specific Selection Fields                  .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I F4_STRUCTURE                  F4 on Structure (incl. Tables)                              .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I F4_TABLE                      F4 for Table                                                .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I FIELDINFO_GET                 Reads Information for All Table Fields                      .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I TABL_GET                      Reads Table in Dictionary                                   .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I TRANSFORM_FIELDNAME           Replaces Tech. Field Name where Necessary                   .
IF_QUERY_DDIC                  I TRANSFORM_TABNAME             Replaces Tech. Table Name where Necessary                   .
IF_QUERY_DOCUMENTATION         I INFOSET_DOCU                  InfoSet Documentation                                       .
IF_QUERY_DOCUMENTATION         I QUERY_DOCU                    Query Documentation                                         .
IF_QUERY_IMPORT_EXPORT         I ON_QUERY_DELETE               Extra when Deleting a Query                                 .
IF_QUERY_IMPORT_EXPORT         I ON_QUERY_RENAME               Extra when Renaming a Query                                 .
IF_QUERY_IMPORT_EXPORT         I ON_QUERY_SAVE                 Extra when Saving a Query                                   .
IF_QUERY_INFOSET_GENERATOR     I MODIFY_INFOSET                Modifying an SAP Query InfoSet                              .
IF_QUERY_JOIN                  I SET_STANDARD_CONDITION        Determining Join Conditions                                 .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I DISPLAY_EXIT                  Exit Object Display                                         .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I GET_EVALUATION_SET            Determine Evalualtion Set                                   .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I GET_OBJECT_SET_TEXTS          Set Texts for Object Set                                    .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Object Handling                                  .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I SELECT_OBJECTS                Determine Object Set                                        .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I START_QUERY                   Execute Query with Hit List                                 .
IF_QUERY_OBJECT_HANDLING       I START_REPORT                  Carry Out Report with Hit List                              .
IF_QUERY_TAB_ACCESS_AUTHORITY  I ACCESS_AUTHORITY_BEGIN        Begin Check                                                 .
IF_QUERY_TAB_ACCESS_AUTHORITY  I ACCESS_AUTHORITY_END          End Check                                                   .
IF_QUERY_TAB_ACCESS_AUTHORITY  I TAB_ACCESS_AUTHORITY          Check Access Authorization for a Table                      .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_CHECK_INFOSET            Check InfoSet                                               .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_CHECK_QUERY              Ceck Query                                                  .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_CHECK_USERGROUP          Check User Group                                            .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_DELETE_INFOSET           Delete InfoSet                                              .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_DELETE_QUERY             Delete Query                                                .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_DELETE_USERGROUP         Delete User Group                                           .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_INSERT_INFOSET           Save InfoSet                                                .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_INSERT_QUERY             Save Query                                                  .
IF_QUERY_TRANSPORT_REQUEST     I CORR_INSERT_USERGROUP         Save User Group                                             .
IF_RANDOM_NUMBER               I GET_RANDOM_FLOAT              Generate Floating Point Number [0,1]                        .
IF_RANDOM_NUMBER               I GET_RANDOM_INT                Generate Integer4 Random Number [0,R-1]                     .
IF_RANDOM_NUMBER               I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I FIND_ASSIGNED_CHARACT         Find Instance of a Characteristic Assignment in RAM         .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I GET_CHARACT                   Pass Characteristic for Assignment                          .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I GET_ELEMENT_TYPE              Pass Development Element Type for Assignment                .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I REFRESH_FROM_DB               Read from Database and Update Attributes                    .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I SET_CHANGEABLE                Allow Changes to Instance                                   .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I SET_DELETED                   Delete Instance (Logically)                                 .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I SET_MANDATORY_ASSIGN          Set Required Assignment of Char. Value to Dev. Element      .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_CHARACTERISTIC I UPDATE_DB                     Save/Change/Delete THIS Instance in the Database            .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I FIND_ASSIGNED_VALUE           Find Instance of a Characteristic Value Assignment in Memory.
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I GET_CHARACT                   Pass Characteristic for Assignment                          .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I GET_CHARACT_VALUE             Pass Characteristic Value for Assignment                    .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I GET_ELEMENT_TYPE              Pass Development Element Type for Assignment                .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I REFRESH_FROM_DB               Read from Database and Update Attributes                    .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I SET_CHANGEABLE                Allow Changes to Instance                                   .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I SET_DELETED                   Delete Instance (Logically)                                 .
IF_RCL_ASSIGNED_VALUE          I UPDATE_DB                     Save/Change/Delete THIS Instance in the Database            .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I ADD_CHARACT_VALUE             Add Characteristic Value to Characteristic                  .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I FIND_CHARACT                  Find Instance of a Characteristic in Memory                 .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_ASSIGNED_CHARACT_COLL     Pass Set of Characteristic Assignments                      .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_CHARACT_VALUE_COLL        Pass Set of Characteristic Values                           .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_LONG_TEXT                 Copy Long Description (SAPScript Docu)                      .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_LONG_TEXT_ID              Copy ID of Long Description (SAPScript Docu)                .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_LONG_TEXT_TEMPLATE        Copy a Template for the Long Description                    .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I GET_SHORT_TEXT                Pass Short Description                                      .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I READ_ALL_SHORT_TEXTS          Read ALL Short Descrips. of Characteristics and Char. Values.
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I REFRESH_FROM_DB               Read from Database and Update Attributes                    .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I REMOVE_CHARACT_VALUE          Remove Characteristic Value from Characteristic             .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I REORDER_CHARACT_VALUE_COLL    Sort Set of Characteristic Values                           .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I SET_ALLOW_MULTIPLE_VALUES     Set Permission for Several Values Per Characteristic        .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I SET_CHANGEABLE                Allow Changes to Instance                                   .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I SET_DELETED                   Delete Instance (Logically)                                 .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I SET_LONG_TEXT                 Change long Description (SAPScript Docu)                    .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I SET_SHORT_TEXT                Change Short Description                                    .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC          I UPDATE_DB                     Save/Change/Delete THIS Instance in the Database            .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I FIND_CHARACT_VALUE            Find Instance of a Characteristic Value in Memory           .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I GET_CHARACT                   Pass Characteristic                                         .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I GET_SHORT_TEXT                Pass Short Description                                      .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I REFRESH_FROM_DB               Read from Database and Update Attributes                    .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I SET_CHANGEABLE                Allow Changes to Instance                                   .
IF_RCL_CHARACTERISTIC_VALUE    I SET_SHORT_TEXT                Change Short Description                                    .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_ASSIGNED_CHARACT      Release Short-Term Lock for Characteristic Assignment       .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_ASSIGNED_VALUE        Cancel Technical Short-Term Lock for Char. Value Assignment .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_ASSIGNED_VALUE_SEMANT Cancel Semantic Short-Term Lock for Char. Value Assignment  .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_CHARACT               Release Short-Term Lock for Characteristic                  .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_CHARACT_VALUE         Release Short-Term Lock for Characteristic Value            .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I DEQUEUE_ELEMENT_TYPE          Release Short-Term Lock for Development Element Type        .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_ASSIGNED_CHARACT      Set Short-Term Lock for Characteristic Assignment           .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_ASSIGNED_VALUE        Set Technical Short-Term Lock for Char. Value Assignment    .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_ASSIGNED_VALUE_SEMANT Set Semantic Short-Term Lock for Char. Value Assignment     .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_CHARACT               Set Short-Term Lock for Characteristic                      .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_CHARACT_VALUE         Set Short-Term Lock for Characteristic Value                .
IF_RCL_CLASSIFICATION_HELPER   I ENQUEUE_ELEMENT_TYPE          Set Short-Term Lock for Development Element Type            .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I FIND_ELEMENT_TYPE             Find Instance of a Development Element Type in RAM          .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I GET_ASSIGNED_CHARACT_COLL     Pass Set of Characteristic Assignments                      .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I GET_SHORT_TEXT                Pass Short Description                                      .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I READ_ALL_SHORT_TEXTS          Read ALL Short Descriptions                                 .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I REFRESH_FROM_DB               Read from Database and Update Attributes                    .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I REORDER_ASSIGNED_CHARACT_COLL Sort Set of Assigned Characteristics                        .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I SET_CHANGEABLE                Allow Changes to Instance                                   .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I SET_DELETED                   Delete Instance (Logically)                                 .
IF_RCL_ELEMENT_TYPE            I UPDATE_DB                     Save/Change/Delete Instance in Database                     .
IF_RCM_CASE_WD_API             I BUILD_STATUS                  Dynamically Visualize Status of Elements on View and Context.
IF_RCM_CASE_WD_API             I GET_CASE_TYPES                Create Case Type Selection List                             .
IF_RCM_CASE_WD_API             I SET_STATUS                    Adapt Status Element Visualization to View and Context      .
IF_RCM_COMPONENT               I GET_TRANS_EXEC                Returns the Implementation for Declared State Transition    .
IF_RCM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_MODEL I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              Return All Elements                                         .
IF_RCM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_MODEL I GET_DIRECT_CHILDS_OF_ELEMENT  Return Elements of a Parent                                 .
IF_RCM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_MODEL I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             Return Element                                              .
IF_RCM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_MODEL I GET_ELEMENT_COLLECTION        Return Collection                                           .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I ADD_TOOLBAR_ITEM_2_UPD        Set the toolbar items that needs updating                   .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I ARE_TRANS_FOR_ELEM_TO_SET     Do transitions need to be set for the current element?      .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I GET_COLUMN_SETTING            Return a Column                                             .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I GET_COLUMN_SETTINGS           Return Columns                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I GET_TOOLBAR_ITEMS_2_UPD       Reset the toolbar items that need updating                  .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I GET_TOOLBAR_SETTINGS          Return Toolbar                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I IS_ALV_MODE                   Elements are Displayed in ALV                               .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I IS_COLUMN_VISIBLE             Returns Whether a Colunn is Visible                         .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I IS_MINIMIZE                   Minimize View?                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I IS_TABLE_HIERARCHICAL         Returns Whether the Table is Flat or Hierarchical           .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I SET_COLUMN_SETTINGS           Set Columns                                                 .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I SET_MINIMIZE                  Set Minimized View                                          .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I SET_TOOLBAR_ITEM_DISPL        Sets the name/icon for a toolbar item                       .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I SET_TOOLBAR_SETTINGS          Set Toolbar                                                 .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I SET_TRANS_FOR_ELEM            Transitions need to be set for the current element          .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_CFG_WD          I TOOLBAR_ITEMS_UPDATED         Toolbar items have been updated                             .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Element                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              Return All Elements                                         .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_CONTAINER_POID            Return POID of the Container                                .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_CURRENT_STATE             Return Current State                                        .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_DEFAULT_COLUMN_SETTINGS   Return Column Settings (Default)                            .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_DEFAULT_TOOLBAR_SETTINGS  Return Toolbar (Default)                                    .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_PARENT        Return Children of an Element                               .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             Return Element                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_SRM                       Return SRM Handle                                           .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I GET_TOOLBAR_SETTINGS          Return Toolbar                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I RENAME_ELEMENT                Rename Element                                              .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I SEARCH_ELEMENT_BY_DESCR       Find Element Using a Description                            .
IF_RCM_ELEMENT_MODEL_WD        I SET_CURRENT_STATE             Set Current State                                           .
IF_RCM_RECORD_VALID_BEF_ELEM   I ADD_ELEMENT                   Run Checks Before Adding Elements                           .
IF_RCM_RECORD_VALID_BEF_ELEM   I DELETE_ELEMENT                Run Checks Before Deleting Elements                         .
IF_RCM_REC_EMBEDDED_WD         I DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTES            Visualize Attributes                                        .
IF_RCM_REC_EMBEDDED_WD         I DISPLAY_HEADER                Display Header (+ Display Detailed View)                    .
IF_RCM_REC_EMBEDDED_WD         I RESTRICTED_TRANSITIONS        Transitions with limited availability                       .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I CHECK_CHG_ROLE_AUTH           Checks if user has authorization for roles                  .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I CLOSE                         Close Record                                                .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I CONNECT_TO_BACKEND            Connect Back End                                            .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I CREATE                        Create Record                                               .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I DELETE                        Delete Record                                               .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Element                                              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              Find All Elements                                           .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_PARENT        Find Elements of a Parent                                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             Find Element Using the ID                                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_API                Return Record API                                           .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_CONTEXT_API        Return Record Context API                                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_EXPERT_API         Return Record Expert API                                    .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_HEADER             Find Record Header                                          .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_MODEL_API          Return API for the Record Model                             .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_MODEL_INFO         Find Info for Associated Record Model                       .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_POID               Return POID for the Record                                  .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_RECORD_SEARCH_API         Returen Search API for Record                               .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I GET_SRM                       Return SRM Handle                                           .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I INSERT_ELEMENT                Insert Element                                              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I IS_IN_CREATION                Checks if record is currently being created, not saved yet  .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I OPEN                          Open Record                                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I RENAME_ELEMENT                Rename Element                                              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL               I SAVE                          Save Record                                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Find Attributes                                             .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I GET_RELATIONS                 Find Relations                                              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I GET_ROLES                     Determine Roles                                             .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I HAS_ORIGINAL_DESCRIPTION      Returns whether the element has a description when created  .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I SET_RELATIONS                 Set Relations                                               .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_ELEMENT       I SET_ROLES                     Set Roles                                                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I CHECK_GET_MIN_CARDI           Elements that violate minimum cardinality                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I CHECK_MODEL_STATE_REL         Check for record models with status 'released'              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I CLOSE                         Close Record                                                .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I CLOSE_EDIT_CONTAINER          Close Transparent Container                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I DELETE_ELEM_BUFFER            Delete Buffer for Elements                                  .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_CONTAINER_CHG_MSG         Get message during change operation in transparent container.
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_CURRENT_STATE             Find Current State                                          .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_IF_RECORD_EMBEDDED        Return Interface for Embedded Record                        .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_MODEL                     Return UI-Independent Model                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_PROPERTY_SERVICE          Find Property Service                                       .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_PROP_REPOSITORY           Find Property Repository                                    .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_RECORD_HEADER             Find Record Header                                          .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_SPECIAL_TRANSITION        Return Special Transition for the Record                    .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_SPECIAL_TRANSITIONS       Find Special Transitions for the Record                     .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I GET_USER_SETTINGS             Return User Settings for Record                             .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I INSERT_ELEMENT                Insert Elements into Record / Transparent Container         .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I IS_ELEMENT_INPLACE_VIS        Is an element being visualized implace at present?          .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I IS_RECORD_EMBEDDED            Is the record embedded?                                     .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I IS_TESTMODE_ACTIVE            Is the record in test mode?                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I IS_TRANSPARENT_ELEMENT        Checks if the container element is transparent              .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I OPEN_EDIT_CONTAINER           Open Transparent Container for Modification                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I SAVE                          Save Record                                                 .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I SET_CURRENT_STATE             Set Current State                                           .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I SET_ELEMENT_INPLACE_VIS       Visualize Inplace Element                                   .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I SET_USER_SETTINGS             Set User Settings for Record                                .
IF_RCM_REC_MODEL_WD            I SYNC_ELEMENT_DESCR            Synchronize Element Description                             .
IF_RCM_SP_COMPONENT            I SET_STATE_MANAGER             Registration of the State Manager to Set Transition Decl.   .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I CONVERT_XML_DATA_TO_TAB       Convert Form Fields from xml to Name-Value Pairs            .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I EXTRACT_FORM_DATA_AS_XML      Extract Form Data from PDF Doc.                             .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I FILL_CONTEXT_NODE_FORM_DATA_WDFill WD Context Node for Form Data                          .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I GET_FORM_DATA                 Find form data that is specified in the PDF form            .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I GET_FORM_LIST                 Get list of the form objects entered on the element type    .
IF_RCM_SP_DOC_PDF_FORM         I HANDLE_FORM_DATA              Get form fields from PDF doc. and edit them                 .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I CLOSE                         Close                                                       .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I CREATE                        Create New Note                                             .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I DELETE                        Delete Note                                                 .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I LOCK                          Set Write Lock                                              .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I OPEN                          Opening a Note                                              .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I READ                          Read Content and Title                                      .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I UNLOCK                        Delete Write Lock                                           .
IF_RCM_SP_NOTE_WD              I WRITE                         Write Content and Title                                     .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER           I ADD_TRANS_DEKL                Announce State Transition                                   .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER           I FIRE_TRANSITION               Trigger State Transition                                    .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER           I GET_CURRENT_STATE             Current State of the Main SP and Other Embedded Objects     .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER           I IS_TRANSITION_ENABLED         Is the state transition permitted?                          .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER           I REMOVE_TRANS_DEKL             Remove State Transition Again                               .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER_EMB       I ADD_EMBEDDABLE                Add Embeddable Object                                       .
IF_RCM_STATE_MANAGER_EMB       I REMOVE_EMBEDDABLE             Remove Embeddable Object                                    .
IF_RCM_STATE_WD                I IS_UI_ATT_EDIT_ENABLED        UI Attributes: Edit Fields Enabled?                         .
IF_RCM_STATE_WD                I IS_UI_ATT_SAVB_ENABLED        UI Attributes: Save Button Enabled?                         .
IF_RCM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_MODL I GET_MODEL                     Find out UI-Independent Model                               .
IF_RCM_TRANS_DECL              I GET_FROM_STATE                State That Is Being Left                                    .
IF_RCM_TRANS_DECL              I GET_SPSID                     General Part of the Name of the Transition                  .
IF_RCM_TRANS_DECL              I GET_TO_STATE                  Target State of the Transition                              .
IF_RCM_TRANS_DECL              I GET_TRANSDECLID               Special Part of this State Transition                       .
IF_RCM_TRANS_EXEC              I EXECUTE                       Execution of the Declared State Transition                  .
IF_RCM_TRANS_EXEC              I IS_ENABLED                    Block State Transition if Required                          .
IF_RCM_WD_INFO_SP              I IS_COMPLEX                    Complex or Simple Display (Part Screen)                     .
IF_RCM_WD_PU_CONTROLLER        I EXECUTE_QUERY                 Execution of Query                                          .
IF_RCM_WD_PU_CONTROLLER        I GET_RESULT_FIELDCAT           Read field catalog                                          .
IF_RCM_WD_PU_CONTROLLER        I GET_SEARCHABLE_SPS_LIST       Gets List of Searchable SPS for POID                        .
IF_RCM_WD_PU_CONTROLLER        I GET_SEARCH_PARAMS             Gets Search Parameters                                      .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I ADD_RESOURCE_TO_COLL          Add new resource to collection                              .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I CREATE_NEW_CHILD              Create New Child Resource                                   .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I DELETE_RESOURCE_FROM_COLL     Delete Resource from Collection                             .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I GET_CHILD_RESOURCE            Create and return child resource by its internal ID         .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I IS_ADD_TO_COLL_ALLOWED        Return TRUE if allowed to add a resource to collection      .
IF_RCM_WEBDAV_COLLECTION       I IS_MOVE_FROM_COLL_ALLOWED     Return TRUE if allowed to move a resource from collection   .
IF_RCP_DISPLAY_OPTIONS         I ICON_MODIFY                   Change Icon                                                 .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I CHECK_LINE                    Check Row in ALV Grid                                       .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I FILL_LINE                     Fill Row for ALV Grid                                       .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I GET_VALUE                     Gets Value for Single Field                                 .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I INIT_FCAT                     Read and Initialize Field Catalog                           .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I PROVIDE_CHARS                 Fetch Characteristics of a Class                            .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I SET_VALUE                     Sets Values for Single Fields                               .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I UPDATE_LINE_STYLE             Update Row Style                                            .
IF_RCP_PP_UI_BASE              I UPDATE_MAPPING                Update Characteristic/Field Assignment                      .
IF_RCP_WBO_FRM                 I CALL_MASTER_FOR_DISPLAY       Parent of a Dep. FRM Is to Display This on its Tab Page     .
IF_RCV_RECEIVER_DETERMINATION  I CORR_DATA_2_REQUEST_MOVE      Transfer Data for Correspondence Creation to Request        .
IF_RDM_BAPI_PROMO_CREATE       I CHECK_ATTRIBUTES              Check Attributes, Transfer From PROMOTION_HEADER to WAKH    .
IF_RDM_BAPI_PROMO_CREATE       I CHECK_DISCOUNTS               Checks for Creation of Discounts                            .
IF_RDM_BAPI_PROMO_CREATE       I SET_ATTRIBUTES_FROM_PROMO_TYPETransfer Attributes From Promotion Type to WAKH             .
IF_RDM_BAPI_PROMO_CREATE       I SET_OFFER_TYPE                Transfer Quotation Type From ITEMS to WAKP                  .
IF_RDM_PROMOTION_WAK1          I COPY_ATTRIBUTES               Copy Attributes of Reference Promotion                      .
IF_RDM_PROMOTION_WAK1          I SET_ATTRIBUTES_FROM_PROMO_TYPETransfer Attributes From Promotion Type to WAKH             .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_DISCOUNTS_ADD           Promotion Discounts That Are Inserted in the DB             .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_DISCOUNTS_DEL           Promotion Discounts That Are Deleted From the DB            .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_DISCOUNTS_UPD           Promotion Discounts That Are Changed in the DB              .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_HEADER_ADD              Promotion Header Data That is Inserted in the DB            .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_HEADER_DEL              Promotion Header Data That is Deleted From the DB           .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_HEADER_UPD              Promotion Header Data That is Changed in the DB             .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_ITEMS_ADD               Promotion Items That Are Inserted into the DB               .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_ITEMS_DEL               Promotion Items That Are Deleted From the DB                .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_ITEMS_UPD               Promotion Items That Are Changed in the DB                  .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_TEXTS_ADD               Promotion Texts That Are Inserted into the DB               .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_TEXTS_DEL               Promotion Texts That Are Deleted From the DB                .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I PROMO_TEXTS_UPD               Promotion Texts That Are Changed in the DB                  .
IF_RDM_PROMO_POST              I SET_OFFER_TYPE                Set Quotation Type on Posting for All Items                 .
IF_RD_RUNTIME                  I GET_RECEIVERS                 Receiver Pre-Identification for a Message                   .
IF_RD_RUNTIME                  I RECEIVERS_EXIST               Determine Whether Potential Receivers Exist                 .
IF_READER_MM                   I CREATE_OBJECT                 Generate and Read Object                                    .
IF_READER_MM                   I READ_INTEGER                  Read Integer                                                .
IF_READER_MM                   I READ_OBJECT                   Read Object                                                 .
IF_READER_MM                   I READ_ROOT                     Read Root                                                   .
IF_READER_MM                   I READ_STRING                   Read String                                                 .
IF_READER_MM                   I READ_TABLE                    Read Table                                                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I COPY_ACTUAL_TO_PLAN           Copies Actual Values to Plan Values                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes an Entry                                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I DELETE_VALUES                 Deletes the Values (Initialization)                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I DISTRIBUTE_COSTS              Distribute Costs                                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I DO_UPDATE                     Performs Update                                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I EXISTS_TEXT                   Asks If a Text Exists                                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_COSTSPOS_FOR_INSERT       Gets Costs Items That Can Be Added                          .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I HANDLE_OBJASS_CHANGE          After Changing the Object Assignment                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager Using Superordinate Object              .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I INSERT_COSTSPOS               Adds a New Costs Item                                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I INSERT_OBJECT                 Adds a New Object                                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSABS_ENABLED           Asks If Absolute Costs Are Allowed?                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSCAP_ENABLED           Asks If Capping of Costs Is Allowed?                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSDEC_ENABLED           Asks If Decrease of Costs Is Allowed                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSINC_ENABLED           Asks If Increase of Costs Is Allowed                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSMAX_ENABLED           Asks If Maximum Costs Are Allowed                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSMEAS_ENABLED          Asks If Costs per Measurement Are Allowed?                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSNOMEAS_ENABLED        Asks If Costs Without Measurement Are Allowed?              .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSPOS_ACTIVE            Asks If Costs Items Are Active?                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_COSTSPOS_ENABLED           Asks If Costs Items Are Allowed?                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_MODIFIED_ACTUAL            Asks If the Actual Values Were Changed                      .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_NOTE_ENABLED               Asks If Memos Are Allowed?                                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_PLAN_ENABLED               Asks If Planned Values Are Allowed?                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I IS_PLAN_FILLED                Asks If the Planned Values Were Filled                      .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I REFRESH                       Cleans Up the Entries                                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I SET_CAPPING_VALUES            Sets the Capping Values                                     .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I SET_COSTSPOS_ACTIVE           Activates/Deactivates Costs Items                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I SET_TEXT                      Sets the Text of the Memo                                   .
IF_REAJ_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR     I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes an Entry                                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ACTIVATEONACT           Checks Actual - Activation Date                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ACTIVATEONPLAN          Checks Plan - Activation Date                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ADJMTASKID              Checks ID of Adjustment Measure                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ADJMTASKTYPE            Checks Type of Adjustment Measure                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_AFFCNIND                Checks Adjustment Type                                      .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_AGAINST_SUPER           Checks Against the Higher-Level Adjustment Measure          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ATMEAS                  Checks Measurement Type and Measurement Unit                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_BENO                    Checks Business Entity                                      .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_CURRENCY                Checks Currency                                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_DOWAIVERCD              Checks 'Set Up Waiver Condition for Capping'                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_ISSUPERADJMTASK         Checks Indicator for Higher-Level Adjustment Measure        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_SUPERADJMTASKID         Checks Identification of Higher-Level Adjustment Measure    .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Valid-From Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDFROMACT            Checks Actual - Start Date of Adjustment Measure            .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDFROMPLAN           Checks Plan - Start Date of Adjustment Measure              .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Valid-To Date of Adjustment Measure                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDTOACT              Checks Actual - End Date of Adjustment Measure              .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_VALIDTOPLAN             Checks Plan - End Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I CHECK_XADJMTASK               Checks Name of Adjustment Measure                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I COPY_ACTUAL_TO_PLAN           Copies Actual Values to Plan Values                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I DO_UPDATE                     Performs Update                                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I ENABLE_PLAN                   Allows Plan Values                                          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I EXISTS_ADJUSTMENT             Asks If an Adjustment Exists?                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I EXISTS_TEXT                   Asks If a Text Exists                                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ACTIVATEONACT             Gets Actual - Activation Date                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ACTIVATEONPLAN            Gets Plan - Activation Date                                 .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ADJMTASKID                Gets ID of Adjustment Measure                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ADJMTASKTYPE              Gets Type of Adjustment Measure                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_AFFCNIND                  Gets Adjustment Type                                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ALLOWED_COSTSPOS_X        Gets the Allowed Costs Items                                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ATMEAS                    Gets Measurement Type and Measurement Unit                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_BENO                      Returns Business Entity                                     .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_BUKRS                     Delivers Company Code                                       .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_CONDTYPES                 Gets the Adjustment Condition Types                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_CURRENCY                  Gets Currency                                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_DOWAIVERCD                Gets 'Set Up Waiver Condition for Capping'                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_ISSUPERADJMTASK           Gets Indicator for Higher-Level Adjustment Measure          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_RULE_TASK                 Gets Adjustment Rule TASK                                   .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_SUPERADJMTASKID           Gets Identification of Higher-Level Adjustment Measure      .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Valid-From Date of Adjustment Measure                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDFROMACT              Gets Actual - Start Date of Adjustment Measure              .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDFROMPLAN             Gets Plan - Start Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Valid-To Date of Adjustment Measure                    .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDTOACT                Gets Actual - End Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_VALIDTOPLAN               Gets Plan - End Date of Adjustment Measure                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I GET_XADJMTASK                 Gets Name of Adjustment Measure                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I HAS_SUB_TASKS                 Asks If Submeasures Exist                                   .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSABS_ENABLED           Asks If Absolute Costs Are Allowed?                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSCAP_ENABLED           Asks If Capping of Costs Is Allowed?                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSDEC_ENABLED           Asks If Decrease of Costs Is Allowed                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSINC_ENABLED           Asks If Increase of Costs Is Allowed                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSMAX_ENABLED           Asks If Maximum Costs Are Allowed                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSMEAS_ENABLED          Asks If Costs per Measurement Are Allowed?                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSNOMEAS_ENABLED        Asks If Costs Without Measurement Are Allowed?              .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSPOS_ACTIVE            Asks If Costs Items Are Active?                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_COSTSPOS_ENABLED           Asks If Costs Items Are Allowed?                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_NOTE_ENABLED               Asks If the Memo Is Allowed?                                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_OVERVIEW_ENABLED           Asks If the Overview Is Allowed?                            .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_PERIOD_ENABLED             Is the Validity Allowed?                                    .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_PLAN_ENABLED               Asks If Planned Values Are Allowed?                         .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_PLAN_FILLED                Asks If the Planned Values Were Filled                      .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_SUB_ADJMTASK               Gets If Measure Is Subordinate Adjustment Measure           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_SUB_ADJMTASK_ENABLED       Is Subordinate Adjustment Measure Allowed?                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_SUPER_ADJMTASK             Gets Whether the Measure Is a Higher-Level Measure          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I IS_SUPER_ADJMTASK_ENABLED     Is the Higher-Level Measure Allowed?                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ACTIVATEONACT             Sets Actual - Activation Date                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ACTIVATEONPLAN            Sets Plan - Activation Date                                 .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ADJMTASKID                Sets ID of Adjustment Measure                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ADJMTASKTYPE              Sets Type of Adjustment Measure                             .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_AFFCNIND                  Sets Adjustment Type                                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ATMEAS                    Sets Measurement Type and Measurement Unit                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_BENO                      Sets Business Entity                                        .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_BUKRS                     SEts Company Code                                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_CAPPING_VALUES            Sets the Capping Values                                     .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_CHECK_BY_METHOD           Switches on Check Mode for Method                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_COSTSPOS_ACTIVE           Activates/Deactivates Costs Items                           .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_CURRENCY                  Sets Currency                                               .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_DOWAIVERCD                Sets 'Set Up Waiver Condition for Capping'                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_ISSUPERADJMTASK           Sets Indicator for Higher-Level Adjustment Measure          .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_SUPERADJMTASKID           Sets Identification of Higher-Level Adjustment Measure      .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_TEXT                      Sets the Text of the Memo                                   .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Valid-From Date of Adjustment Measure                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDFROMACT              Sets Actual - Start Date of Adjustment Measure              .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDFROMPLAN             Sets Plan - Start Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Valid-To Date of Adjustment Measure                    .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDTOACT                Sets Actual - End Date of Adjustment Measure                .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_VALIDTOPLAN               Sets Plan - End Date of Adjustment Measure                  .
IF_REAJ_ADJUSTMENT_TASK        I SET_XADJMTASK                 Sets Name of Adjustment Measure                             .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code of Comparative Group                    .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I CHECK_COMPGRP                 Checks Number of Comparative Group                          .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Valid-From Date of Comparative Group                 .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Valid-To Date of Comparative Group                   .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I CHECK_XCOMPGRP                Checks Name of Comparative Group                            .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_BUKRS                     Gets Compayn Code of Comparative Group                      .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_COMPGRP                   Gets Number of Comparative Group                            .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Valid-From Date of Comparative Group                   .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Valid-To Date of Comparative Group                     .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I GET_XCOMPGRP                  Gets Name of Comparative Group                              .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I SET_BUKRS                     Sets Company Code of Comparative Group                      .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I SET_COMPGRP                   Sets Number of Comparative Group                            .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Valid-From Date of Comparative Group                   .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Valid-To Date of Comparative Group                     .
IF_REAJ_COMPARE_GROUP          I SET_XCOMPGRP                  Sets Name of Comparative Group                              .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I CAN_SPECIFIC                  Delivers Whether Specific Indicators Can Be Set             .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I COMPARE_WITH_INSTANCE         Compares the Data with Transferred Instance [Final]         .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_CHANGEABLE                Delivers the Change Possibility                             .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_INDEX                     Gets Index of Sub-Rule [Final]                              .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_KEY                       Gets Key [Final]                                            .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_PERIOD                    Gets Validity [Final]                                       .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_SUBTYPE                   Gets Differentiator [Final]                                 .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I GET_TEXT                      Gets Standard Text [Final]                                  .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I HAS_SPECIFIC_FIELDS           Determines Whether a Field Must Be Stipulated Specifically  .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I INIT_BY_OTHER                 Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I IS_ACTIVE                     Gets Active Indicator [Final]                               .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I IS_ANNOUNCE                   Gets the Notification Indicator                             .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I IS_APPROVAL                   Supplies Approval Indicator                                 .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I IS_SPECIFIC                   Gets Specific Indicator                                     .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_ACTIVE                    Sets or Deletes Active Indicator [Final]                    .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_DELETE                    Selects the Object As Object to Be Deleted                  .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_DETAIL_BY_INSTANCE        Sets Field String Using Transferring Instance [Final]       .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_PERIOD                    Sets Validity                                               .
IF_REAJ_GLOBAL_MNGR            I SET_SPECIFIC                  Sets or Deletes the Specific Indicator [Final]              .
IF_REAJ_HAS_ADJM_TASK_OBJ      I GET_ADJM_TASK_OBJ_MNGR        Gets Manager - Adjustment Measure Object                    .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I BADI_AFTER_STORE              Calls the BAdI Implementation                               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I BUILD_NEXT_ADJM_DATE          Generates Date of Next Possible Adjustment                  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CAN_SEND_ADJMVAR_MESSAGE      Asks If Standard Message Can Be Written                     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CAPPING_ADJUSTMENT            Caps the Calculated Adjustment [final]                      .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CHECK_ADJUSTMENT_PARAMETER    Checks the Cross-Method Process Parameters                  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CHECK_PARAMETER               Checks the Method-Specific Process Parameters [Abstract]    .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CORRECT_ADJUSTMENT            Corrects the Calculated Adjustment [Final]                  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I CORRECT_BASISDATE             Corrects Base Date of Adjustment, If Necessary              .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I DO_ADJUSTMENT                 Performs the Adjustment for an Object [Final]               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I DO_ADJUSTMENT_CONDITION       Performs the Adjustment for a Condition [abstrakt]          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I EVALUATION_CONTROL_BLOCK      Gets Next Processing Block of Control Table                 .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I EXISTS_PARAMETER_FOR_METHOD   Asks If Method-Specific Process Parameters Exist [Abstract] .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I FILL_BUFFER_BY_METHREFGUID    Fills Buffer According to Transferred Reference [Abstract]  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I FILL_VALUES_FOR_ADJMVAR       Fills the Values for Variables of the Control Table         .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I FILL_VALUES_FOR_ADJMVAR_CUST  Fills the Values for Customer-Specific Variables            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I FREE_DATA_AFTER_ADJM          Releases Data That Is Not Needed                            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_ADJMVARUSE_INFO           Gets Information for Variables                              .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_ADJM_RECORD_STATUS        Gets Status of a Condition Adjustment [Final]               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_ADJM_VALID_FROM           Gets Date of Next Adjustment                                .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_CONDITION_VALUES          Gets Unit Price and Condition Amount                        .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_CONTROL_BLOCK             Gets Next Processing Block of Control Table                 .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION       Gets Informational Values for Condition Adjustment [Final]  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_FIELDCATALOG_CONDREL      Gets the Field Catalog for Condition Assignment [Abstract]  .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_FIELDCATALOG_RECORD       Gets the Field Catalog for the Adjustment [Abstract]        .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_FIRST_ADJM_DATE           Gets Date of First Successful Adjustment [Final]            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_INTERVAL_NEXT_ADJM_DATE   Gets Limits of Next Possible Adjustment [Final]             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_LANGU_FOR_ADJMVAR         Gets Maintenance Language for Control Table                 .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_LAST_ADJM_DATE            Gets Date of the Last Adjustment Made [Final]               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_MAX_ADJMVAR_INDEX         Returns Maximum Index of Value Table                        .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_METHOD                    Gets Adjustment Method [Abstract]                           .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_MSGVAR_FOR_CONTROL_LINE   Gets Message Texts for Row of Control Table                 .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_NEXT_ADJM_DATE            Gets Date of Next Possible Adjustment [Final]               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_NEXT_BLOCKNR              Gets Next Block Number                                      .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_PARENT_POINTER            Supplies Parent Objects of Correct Type [Final]             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I GET_SELECTION                 Gets Method-Specific Object Selection [Abstract]            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I HAS_MSGLIST_ERRORS            Asks If There Are Error Messages                            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I IGNORE_ADJMVAR_INDEX          Asks If Index Should Be Ignored                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I INIT_ADJUSTMENT_CONTROL_RULE  Initializes the Adjustment Control Rule                     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I INIT_BY_CONTEXT               Initializes the Method Using the Context [Final]            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I IS_FROM_ONLY_CHANGED_BY_METHODValid-From Can Only Be Calculated by Method?                .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I IS_NEXTADJMFROM_ACTIVE        Asks If Next Possible Valid-From Is Always Active           .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I IS_NEXT_ADJM_DATE_CHANGEABLE  Is the date of the next adjustment modifiable? [Final]      .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I IS_TAKEVALUE_MODE_ACTIVE      Asks If Transfer Mode Is Active                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I REVERSAL                      Adjustment Record Is Reversed [Abstract]                    .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I ROUNDING_ADJUSTMENT           Rounds the Calculated Adjustment [Final]                    .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SET_MODE                      Sets the Mode of Process [Final]                            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SET_NEW_ADJMCTRLRULE          Sets a New Adjustment Control Rule                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets the Parameters for the Method [Abstract]               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SET_PROCESSGUID               Sets the Process GUID [Final]                               .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SHIFT_DATE_TO_NOTICE_DATE     Shifts Date to Next Notice Date [Final]                     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I SORT_ADJMVAR                  Sorts the Table of Variables for the Control Table          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD                 I USE_ADJMVAR_DEFINITELY        Asks If Control Table Is Always Used                        .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_COMP            I GET_COMP_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_COMP            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_COMP            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_COMP            I GET_RECCOMP_BY_CONDGUID       Gets Data Record from VIAJRECCOMP                           .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_FREE            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_FREE            I GET_FREE_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_FREE            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_FREE            I GET_RECFREE_BY_CONDGUID       Gets Data Record of VIAJRECFREE                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I CHANGE_SPECIFIC_OBJECT        Changes Specific or Object Data Before Adjustment           .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_ACTUAL_INDEX_BASE         Gets Current Point Level for Today's Date                   .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_FIRST_ADJM_INDEX_BASE     Supplies Point Level at First Adjustment                    .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_INDEX_BASE_BY_DATE        Gets Point Level for Date                                   .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_INDEX_CHANGE_PERCENT      Supplies Percentage Change in Points                        .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_INDEX_CHANGE_POINTS       Supplies Absolute Change in Points                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_INDEX_LAST_MAINTAIN       Gets Last Maintained Points with Date                       .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_INDX_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_LAST_ADJM_INDEX_BASE      Supplies Point Level at Last Adjustment                     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_INDX            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_RLRA            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_RLRA            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_RLRA            I GET_RECRLRA_BY_CONDGUID       Gets Data Record from VIAJRECRLRA                           .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_RLRA            I GET_RLRA_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_ADJMRULE_BY_ADJMMETH      Gets the Rule for Indexed Method                            .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_RECTASK_BY_CONDGUID       Gets Data Record of VIAJRECTASK                             .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_TASKTYPE_BY_ADJMRULE      Gets the Adjustment Measure Type for Rule                   .
IF_REAJ_METHOD_TASK            I GET_TASK_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_COMP_MNGR       I DO_PREASSIGNMENT              Carries Out Preassignment When Creating                     .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_COMP_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_COMP_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_COMP_MNGR       I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_INDX_MNGR       I DO_PREASSIGNMENT              Carries Out Preassignment When Creating                     .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_INDX_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_INDX_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_INDX_MNGR       I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I CHECK_ALL_GLOBAL              Checks Cross-Method Depending Upon Specific                 .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I CHECK_ALL_SPECIFIC            Checks Method-Specific Depending Upon Specific              .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I COMPARE_WITH_INSTANCE         Compares the Data with Transferring Instance                .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I GET_INDEX                     Gets Index of Sub-Rule [Final]                              .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I GET_KEY                       Gets Key [Final]                                            .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I GET_PERIOD                    Gets Validity [Final]                                       .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I GET_TEXT                      Gets Standard Text [Final]                                  .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I INIT_BY_OTHER                 Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I SET_DELETE                    Selects the Object As Object to Be Deleted                  .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I SET_DETAIL_BY_INSTANCE        Sets Field String Using Transferring Instance [Final]       .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I SET_PERIOD                    Sets Validity                                               .
IF_REAJ_OBJECT_MNGR            I VALIDFROM_MOVED               Valid-From Date Moved                                       .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I ENABLE_STEP                   Enables a Given Step                                        .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I FREE_PROCESS                  Releases all resources and locks                            .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_DATA_CONTAINER            Gets If Data Should Be Gotten from Container                .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_MSG_FOR_STEPS             Gets the Messages for the Executed Steps                    .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_PARAM                     Gets Parameter Instance                                     .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_PROCESSMODE               Gets the Process Mode                                       .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_SPECIAL_MESSAGES          Gets Special Messages                                       .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_STEPS                     Gets the Selected Process Steps                             .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_STEP_ADJM                 Gets Step ADJM                                              .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_STEP_MANI                 Gets Step MANI                                              .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_STEP_PARAM_BY_TYPE        Gets Step Parameters                                        .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I GET_STEP_REVE                 Gets Step REVE                                              .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_MAINTAIN_POPUP             Returns If Adjustments Are Maintained in Dialog Box         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_PREASSIGN_MODE             Gets If Process Is in Defaulting Mode                       .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_PROCESS_CHECK_ENABLED      Asks If Process Check Is Active?                            .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_STEP_ACTIVE                Asks If Step Is Active                                      .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_STORE_ENABLED              Returns If Process Is Allowed to Be Saved                   .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I IS_SUPPORT                    Support Mode?                                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I RUN_ADJUSTMENT                Runs Adjustment                                             .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I SET_DATA_CONTAINER            Sets If Data Should Be Gotten from Container                .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS                I SET_REVERSAL                  Sets Complete Reversal                                      .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I CLEAR_ADJM_PARAM              Deletes Parameter Reference                                 .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_ADJM_PARAM                Gets Parameter Reference                                    .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I HAS_ADJM_PARAM                Asks Whether Parameter References Exist                     .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I IS_NECESSARY                  Asks Whether Step Is Necessary                              .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I IS_SELECTED                   Asks Whether Step Is Selected                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP           I SET_ADJM_PARAM                Sets Parameter Reference                                    .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_ACTIVATE                  Asks If Adjustment Record Can Be Activated                  .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_ANNOUNCE                  Asks If Notification Can Be Given                           .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_APPROVAL                  Asks If Approval Can Take Place                             .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_CHANGE_ANNOUNCETO         Asks If Notification-To Date Can Be Changed                 .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_CHANGE_APPROVALTO         Asks If Approval-To Date Can Be Changed                     .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_CHANGE_DUEDATEUP          Asks If Due Dates of Follow-Up Postings Can Be Changed      .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_CHANGE_FROM               Asks If Valid-From Date Can Be Changed                      .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_CHANGE_PRICE              Asks If Price Can Be Changed                                .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_DECLINE                   Asks If Rejection Can Take Place                            .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_REVERSAL                  Asks If Can Be Reversed                                     .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_SIMULATE                  Asks If Adjustment Can Be Simulated                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I CAN_SWITCH_TO_EXECUTION       Asks If Change to Update Run Allowed?                       .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I EXISTS_RECORD                 Asks If Adjustment Records Exist                            .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I EXPAND_RECORD                 Enhances an Adjustment Record                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_EXPANDED_RECORD           Gets the Enhanced Adjustment Record                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_MSG_FOR_CONDITION         Gets Messages for a Condition                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_MSG_FOR_OBJECT            Gets Messages for an Object                                 .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_RECORDS                   Gets Adjustment Records for Process                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_RECORDS_X                 Gets the Enhanced Adjustment Records for Process            .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I GET_RECORD_X                  Gets an Enhanced Adjustment Record for Process              .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I IS_CONTINUATION               Asks If the Process Is in Continuation Mode                 .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I IS_ONLY_SIMULATE              Aks If the Adjustment Is Being Simulated                    .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I MODIFY_RECORDS                Adjusts the Adjustment Records to the Process               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I SET_MESSAGE_BUFFER            Sets the Message Buffer Indicator                           .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I SET_RECORDS                   Sets the Adjustment Records for the Process                 .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_ADJM      I SET_RECORDS_X                 Sets the Enhanced Adjustment Records for the Process        .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_MANI      I DELETE_WORKLIST_ENTRY         Deletes an Entry from the Worklist                          .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_MANI      I GET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDCATALOG   Gets Additional Method-Dependent Field Catalogs             .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_MANI      I GET_WORKLIST                  Gets Worklist                                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_MANI      I INSERT_WORKLIST_ENTRY         Adds an Entry to the Worklist                               .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_MANI      I IS_WORKLIST_ENTRY             Asks If an Entry Exists in Worklist                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I APPEND_PARAMETER_OBJECTS      Completes the Parameter Data                                .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I ENABLE_STEP                   Enables a Given Step                                        .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I GET_PARAMETER                 Gets Parameter Data                                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I IS_STEP_NECESSARY             Asks Whether A Specific Step Is Necessary                   .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I IS_STEP_SELECTED              Asks Whether A Specific Step Was Selected                   .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets Parameter Data                                         .
IF_REAJ_PROCESS_STEP_REVE      I IS_FULL_REVERSAL              Asks If Can Be Reversed                                     .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I CAN_SPECIFIC                  Delivers Whether Specific Indicators Can Be Set             .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I CHECK_ALL_GLOBAL              Checks Cross-Method Depending Upon Specific                 .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I CHECK_ALL_OBJECT              Checks Object-Specific Depending Upon Specific              .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I COMPARE_WITH_INSTANCE         Compares the Data with Transferring Instance                .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists                                 .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_CHANGEABLE                Delivers the Change Possibility                             .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_INDEX                     Gets Index of Sub-Rule [Final]                              .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_KEY                       Gets Key [Final]                                            .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_PERIOD                    Gets Validity [Final]                                       .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_SUBTYPE                   Gets Differentiator [Final]                                 .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I GET_TEXT                      Gets Standard Text [Final]                                  .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I HAS_SPECIFIC_FIELDS           Determines Whether a Field Must Be Stipulated Specifically  .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I INIT_BY_OTHER                 Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I IS_ACTIVE                     Gets Active Indicator [Final]                               .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I IS_SPECIFIC                   Gets Specific Indicator                                     .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I SET_ACTIVE                    Sets or Deletes Active Indicator [Final]                    .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I SET_DELETE                    Selects the Object As Object to Be Deleted                  .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I SET_DETAIL_BY_INSTANCE        Sets Field String Using Transferring Instance [Final]       .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I SET_PERIOD                    Sets Validity                                               .
IF_REAJ_SPECIFIC_MNGR          I SET_SPECIFIC                  Sets or Deletes the Specific Indicator [Final]              .
IF_REAJ_SPEC_INDX_MNGR         I GET_ACTUAL_BASEYEAR           Gets Current Base Year                                      .
IF_REAJ_SPEC_INDX_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REAJ_SPEC_INDX_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REAJ_SPEC_INDX_MNGR         I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Structure                                            .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I DELETE_DATE_NEXT_ADJUSTMENT   Delete Date of Next Adjustment                              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I DELETE_DETAIL                 Delete Structure                                            .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I DO_PREASSIGNMENT              Carries Out Preassignment When Creating                     .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_ADDITIONAL_FIELDCATALOG   Gets Additional Method-Dependent Field Catalog              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_ADJMRULE                  Gets Adjustment Rule                                        .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_ADJM_RECORDS_BY_CONDGUID  Gets Adjustment Records for Condition GUID                  .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_CONDITIONS                Gets Condition for Rule                                     .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DATE_NEXT_ADJUSTMENT      Gets Date of Next Adjustment                                .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DATE_SLICES               Supplies the Time Slots                                     .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Field String                                           .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Supplies Structure by Key Date                              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_GLOBAL_POINTER            Gets Pointer for Active Cross-Method                        .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_IDENT_FOR_MESSAGE         Gets Identification for Error Messages                      .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_INDEX_BY_KEY              Gets Indices (RULE and SUBRULE) for Access                  .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_INDEX_RANGE               Gets Index Interval for Term Number                         .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_INDEX_SUBRULE_BY_KEY      Gets Index (SUBRULE) for Access                             .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_INDEX_VALIDFROM           Gets the Index for the Term Number and Start                .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_INTRENO                   Supplies the Real Estate Key                                .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST                      Gets Adjustment Terms                                       .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST_BY_ADJMRULE          Gets the Adjustment Terms for Adjustment Rule               .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Gets Adjustment Terms                                       .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Adjustment Terms Including Additional Data             .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST_X_BY_TERMNO          Gets Adjustment Terms Including Additional Data             .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_OBJECT_POINTER            Gets Pointer to Object-Specific                             .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_OBJTYPE                   Supplies the Object Type Containing the Adjustment Terms    .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_PARENT_POINTER            Supplies Parent Objects of Correct Type (Contract/RO)       .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_RULE_POINTER              Supplies the Time-Dependent Rule Pointer Table              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I GET_SPECIFIC_POINTER          Supplies Pointer to Active Procedure-Specific               .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I HAS_PERIOD                    Queries Whether Time-Dependency Was Used                    .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I HAS_SPECIFIC_GLOBAL           Do Global Parameters (All Procedures) Have Specific Fields? .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I HAS_SPECIFIC_SPECIFIC         Do Procedure-Specific Parameters Have Specific Fields?      .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_INDIVIDUAL_GLOBAL          Local Global Parameters (All Procedures)?                   .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_INDIVIDUAL_SPECIFIC        Local Procedure-Specific Parameters?                        .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_MODIFIED_GLOBAL            Have Local Global Parameters (All Procedures) Been Changed? .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_MODIFIED_OBJECT            Local Object-Specific Parameters Been Changed?              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_MODIFIED_SPECIFIC          Have Local Procedure-Specific Parameters Been Changed?      .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I IS_OK_SUBRULE                 Checks if Errors/Warnings Exist for Subordinate Objects     .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I NEW_BY_DATE                   Generates a New Entry for Date                              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SET_DATE_NEXT_ADJUSTMENT      Sets Date of Next Adjustment                                .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SET_DEFAULT_RULE              Sets Default Adjustment Rule                                .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Structure                                           .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SORT                          Sorts the List                                              .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SWITCH_INDIVIDUAL_GLOBAL      Global Parameters (All Procedures): Switch to Local Change  .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I SWITCH_INDIVIDUAL_SPECIFIC    Procedure-Specific Parameters: Switch to Local Change       .
IF_REAJ_TERM_MNGR              I VALIDFROM_MOVED               Valid-From Date Moved                                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I ASSIGN_TO_PARENT              Assigns Object to Parent Object                             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_AOFUNCTION              Checks Function of Architectural Object                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_AOID                    Checks Identification of Architectural Object               .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_AONR                    Checks Number of Architectural Object                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_AOTYPE                  Checks Architectural Object Type                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_CONDITION               Checks Condition of Building                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DANTBAU                 Checks Application for Building Permit                      .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DATES                   Checks Dates (Year of Modernization, Etc.)                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DBAUBEGI                Checks Construction Start Date                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DBAUGENE                Checks Date of Building Permit                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DBAUVOR                 Checks Planning Inquiry Date                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DBEZUGSF                Checks Date When Ready for Occupation                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DFERTIG                 Checks Completion                                           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DFRDBIS                 Checks Public Funding To                                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DFRDVON                 Checks Public Funding From                                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DOORPLT                 Check Room Number                                           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DSCHLUSS                Checks Final Inspection                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_DVORBES                 Checks Date of Prior Notice                                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_FLOORS                  Checks Floors                                               .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_HIERARCHY               Checks the Architectural Hierarchy                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_JERBBAU                 Checks Heritable Building Right Indicator                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_JNURJAHR                Checks Ind.: Only regard construction date in terms of years.
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_LASTRENO                Checks Date of Last Redecoration                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_MEASSTRC                Checks Measurement Structure                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NTBMZ                   Checks Actual Usage: Construction Dimension Number          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NTGFZ                   Checks Actual Usage: Floor Area Ratio                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NTGRZ                   Checks Actual Usage: Site Occupancy Index                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NZBMZ                   Checks Permitted Usage: Construction Dimension Number       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NZGFZ                   Checks Permitted Usage: Floor Area Ratio                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_NZGRZ                   Checks Permitted Usage: Site Occupancy Index                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_PARENT                  Checks Higher-Level Object Type                             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_PARTAOID                Checks Code for AOID                                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_PARTSEPARATOR           Checks Separator for Code                                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_RBEPLAN                 Checks Development Plan                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_RGEBART                 Checks Type of Building                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_RGEBZUST                Checks Condition of Building                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_RGRNART                 Checks Building Usage Type According to Land Use Map        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_RNBPLAN                 Checks Usage Type According to Development Plan             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SGRART                  Checks Type of Property                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SGRFRM                  Checks Property Ground Type                                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SGRGZS                  Checks Overall Condition of Property                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SGRQAL                  Checks Property: Quality of Location                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SINSTBEZ                Checks Maintenance District                                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SLAGEWE                 Checks the Number of the BE Location                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SLAGK                   Checks Location Class                                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SOBJLAGE                Checks Indicator for District Location of Object            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SUNUTZA                 Checks Main Usage Type                                      .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_SVERKEHR                Checks Transport Connection of BE                           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_USAGECOMMON             Checks Common Usage of Architectural Object                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_XAO                     Checks Text of Architectural Object                         .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_XBAUGENE                Checks Note on Building Permit                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_XNUTZGRU                Checks Current Usage                                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I CHECK_ZULBAUH                 Checks Permitted Building Height                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I COMPLETE_DATA_BE              Completes the Data of the Business Entity                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I COMPLETE_DATA_BU              Completes the Data of the Building                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I COMPLETE_DATA_PR              Completes the Data of the Property                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GENERATE_AOID                 Generates the AOID from Code, Separator, Parent, ...        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_AOTYPE_CHILD              Supplies Subordinate Architectural Object Types             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_AOTYPE_PARENT             Supplies Superordinate Architectural Object Types           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_FLOORS                    Supplies Floors                                             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_HIERARCHY                 Supplies the Architectural Hierarchy                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_MEASSTRC_FOR_HIERARCHY    Supplies Measurement Structure of Hierarchy Branch          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_PARENT                    Supplies Parent of Object (VIBDNODE)                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I GET_ROOT_OBJECT               Supplies Top Object of Object Hierarchy                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I HAS_PARENTOBJECT              Checks If an Object Has a Higher-Level Object               .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Checks If Object Still Has Subordinate Objects              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I IS_AOTYPE_USED_IN_HIERARCHY   Checks Whether Object Type Already in Hierarchy (Above)     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I IS_ROOT                       Checks If Object Is Top Object of Hierarchy                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I PROPOSE_PARTAOID              Default Generation of Code from AONR                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_AOFUNCTION                Changes Function of Architectural Object                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_AOID                      Changes Identification of Architectural Objects             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_AONR                      Changes Identification of Architectural Objects             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_AOTYPE                    Changes Architectural Object Type                           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DANTBAU                   Changes Application for Building Permit                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DBAUBEGI                  Changes Construction Start Date                             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DBAUGENE                  Changes Building Permit                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DBAUVOR                   Changes Date of Planning Inquiry                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DBEPLAN                   Changes Date of Development Plan                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DBEZUGSF                  Changes Readiness for Occupation                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DFERTIG                   Changes Completion                                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DFRDBIS                   Changes Public Funding To                                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DFRDVON                   Changes Public Funding From                                 .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DIALOGUE_MODE             Sets Dialog Mode =" CheckAll                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DOORPLT                   Changes Room Number                                         .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DSCHLUSS                  Changes Final Inspection                                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_DVORBES                   Changes Date of Prior Notice                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_FLOORS                    Changes Floors                                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_JDENKMAL                  Changes Protection of Historical Monuments                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_JERBBAU                   Changes Heritable Building Right Indicator                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_JUNUTZA                   Changes Indicator: Main Usage Type                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_LASTRENO                  Changes Date of Last Renovation                             .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_MEASSTRC                  Changes Measurement Structure                               .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NTBMZ                     Changes Actual Usage: Construction Dimension Number         .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NTGFZ                     Changes Actual Usage: Floor-Area Ratio                      .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NTGRZ                     Changes Actual Usage: Floor Area                            .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NZBMZ                     Changes Permitted Usage: Construction Dimension Number      .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NZGFZ                     Changes Permitted Usage: Floor-Area Ratio                   .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_NZGRZ                     Changes Permitted Usage: Floor Area                         .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_PARTAOID                  Changes Code for AOID                                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_PARTSEPARATOR             Changes Separator for AOID                                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_RBEPLAN                   Changes Development Plan                                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_RGEBART                   Changes Type of Building                                    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_RGEBZUST                  Changes Overall Condition of Building                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_RGRNART                   Checks Building Usage Type According to Land Use Map        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_RNBPLAN                   Checks Building Usage Type According to Development Plan    .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SGRART                    Changes Property Type                                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SGRFRM                    Changes Property Ground Type                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SGRGZS                    Changes Overall Condition of Property                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SGRQAL                    Changes Property: Quality of Location                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SINSTBEZ                  Changes Maintenance District                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SLAGEWE                   Changes the Number of the BE Location                       .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SOBJLAGE                  Changes Indicator for District Location of Object           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SUNUTZA                   Changes Main Usage Type                                     .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_SVERKEHR                  Changes Transport Connection of BE                          .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_USAGECOMMON               Changes Common Usage Indicator                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes Validity of Object                                  .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_XAO                       Changes Name of Architectural Object                        .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_XBAUGENE                  Changes Building Permit Note                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_XNUTZGRU                  Changes Current Usage of Property                           .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_YAUFBAU                   Changes Year of Reconstruction                              .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_YBAUJAHR                  Changes Year of Construction                                .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_YMODERN                   Changes Year of Modernization                               .
IF_REBD_ARCH_OBJECT            I SET_ZULBAUH                   Changes Permitted Building Height                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_ASSESSMENT_VALUE        Checks Assessment Value with Base Year of Building          .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_BBAUW13                 Checks Building Value                                       .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_BBAUWAKT                Checks Current Building Value                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_BDMCBMRA                Checks Amount per Volume Unit                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_BUILDING_EXECUTION Checks Building Execution Dates                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_BUILDING_PERMIT    Checks Building Permit Dates                                .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_FINAL_INSPECTION   Checks Final Inspection Dates                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_PLANNING_INQUIRY   Checks Planning Inquiry Dates                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_PUBLIC_FUNDING     Checks Public Funding From - To                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DATE_READY_FOR_OCC      Checks Dates Ready for Occupancy                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DNUTZEND                Checks End of Usage                                         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DVERKAUF                Checks Sale Date                                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DVRKPLAN                Checks Planned Sale                                         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_DWIRTUB                 Checks Transfer Usage / Charges                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_FLOORS                  Checks Floors                                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_GEMEINDE                Checks Municipality Key                                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_HASCOP                  Checks If Current Occupancy Principle Used                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_INSURABLE_VALUE         Checks Amount and Type of Insurable Value                   .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_JANLHIE                 Checks Indicator: Asset Allocation Valid for Subordin. Bldg .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_JDENKMAL                Checks Protection of Historical Monuments                   .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_JERBBAU                 Checks Heritable Building Right Indicator                   .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_RGEBART                 Checks Type of Building                                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_RGEBZUST                Checks Overall Condition of Building                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_RLRALOC                 Checks Location Class                                       .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_SGENR                   Checks Building Number                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_SUNUTZA                 Checks Main Usage Type                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Business Entity Number                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_XGETXT                  Checks Building Name                                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_YAUFBAU                 Checks Year of Reconstruction                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_YBAUJAHR                Checks Year of Construction                                 .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I CHECK_YMODERN                 Checks Year of Modernization                                .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_ASSESSMENT_VALUE          Delivers Assessment Value with Base Year of Building        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_ASSET_ACCOUNTING_STATE    Supplies Status of Relationship to Fixed Asset              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_BUSINESS_AREA             Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_BUSINESS_ENTITY           Supplies Business Entity (Object)                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_CURRENCY                  Delivers Currency Valid for Building                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_BUILDING_EXECUTION   Delivers Building Execution Dates                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_BUILDING_PERMIT      Delivers Building Permit Dates                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_FINAL_INSPECTION     Delivers Final Inspection Dates                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_PLANNING_INQUIRY     Delivers Planning Inquiry Dates                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_PUBLIC_FUNDING       Delivers Public Funding From - To                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DATE_READY_FOR_OCC        Delivers Dates Ready for Occupancy                          .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_FLOORS                    Supplies Floors                                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_IMKEY                     Delivers Internal Key for Real Estate Object                .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_INSURABLE_VALUE           Supplies Amount and Type of Insurable Value                 .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_PROFIT_CENTER             Supplies Profit Center                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_RLRA                      Supplies Representative List of Rents                       .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Business Entity Number                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_TAX_JURISDICTION_CODE     Delivers Jurisdiction for Tax Calc. - Tax Jurisdiction Code .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_UNIT_AREA                 Delivers Area Unit Valid for Building                       .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_UNIT_LENGTH               Delivers Length Unit Valid for Building                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_UNIT_VOLUME               Delivers Volume Unit Valid for Building                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I GET_USESRLRA                  Gets Usage of Rep. List of Rents                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Bool: Subordinate Objects Exist                             .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I IS_LOCATION_CLASS_ALLOWED     Bool: Checks If Location Class Can Be Set                   .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_ASSESSMENT_VALUE          Changes Assessment Value with Base Year of Building         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_BBAUW13                   Changes Building Value                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_BBAUWAKT                  Changes Current Building Value                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_BDMCBMRA                  Changes Amount per Volume Unit                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_BUILDING_EXECUTION   Changes Building Execution Dates                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_BUILDING_PERMIT      Changes Building Permit Dates                               .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_FINAL_INSPECTION     Changes Final Inspection Dates                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_PLANNING_INQUIRY     Changes Planning Inquiry Dates                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_PUBLIC_FUNDING       Changes Public Funcing From - To                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DATE_READY_FOR_OCC        Changes Dates Ready for Occupancy                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DNUTZEND                  Changes End of Usage                                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DVERKAUF                  Changes Sale Date                                           .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DVRKPLAN                  Changes Planned Sale                                        .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_DWIRTUB                   Changes Transfer Usage / Charges                            .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_FLOORS                    Changes Floors                                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_GEMEINDE                  Changes Municipality Key                                    .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_HASCOP                    Changes "Uses Current Occupancy Principle"                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_INSURABLE_VALUE           Changes Amount and Type of Insurable Value                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_JANLHIE                   Changes Indicator: Asset allocation valid for subordin. bldg.
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_JDENKMAL                  Changes Protection of Historical Monuments                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_JERBBAU                   Changes Heritable Building Right Indicator                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_RGEBART                   Changes Type of Building                                    .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_RGEBZUST                  Changes Overall Condition of Building                       .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_RLRALOC                   Changes Location Class                                      .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_SGENR                     Changes Building Number                                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_SUNUTZA                   Changes Main Usage Type                                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_SWENR                     Changes Business Entity                                     .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_USESRLRA                  Changes Usage of Rep. List of Rents                         .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes Validity of Object                                  .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_XGETXT                    Changes Text for Building                                   .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_YAUFBAU                   Changes Year of Reconstruction                              .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_YBAUJAHR                  Changes Year of Construction                                .
IF_REBD_BUILDING               I SET_YMODERN                   Changes Year of Modernization                               .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_RLRA                    Checks Representative List of Rents                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SETTL_VARIANTS          Checks Default Settlement Variants                          .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SINSTBEZ                Checks Maintenance District                                 .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SLAGEWE                 Checks the Number of the BE Location                        .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SMIETR                  Checks Tenancy Law                                          .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SOBJLAGE                Checks Indicator for District Location of Object            .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SSTDORT                 Checks Regional Location                                    .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SVERKEHR                Checks Transport Connection of BE                           .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Business Entity Number                               .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_UNITS                   Checks Units of Measure                                     .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_WAERS                   Checks Currency Key                                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_XNOTPL                  Checks No automatic creation of function location allowed   .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I CHECK_XWETEXT                 Checks Business Entity Name                                 .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_BUSINESS_AREA             Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_IMKEY                     Delivers Internal Key for Real Estate Object                .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_PROFIT_CENTER             Supplies Profit Center                                      .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_SETTL_VARIANTS            Supplies Default Settlement Variants                        .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Business Entity Number                             .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_TAX_JURISDICTION_CODE     Delivers Jurisdiction for Tax Calc. - Tax Jurisdiction Code .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I GET_UNITS                     Delivers Units of Measure                                   .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Bool: Subordinate Objects Exist                             .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I IS_FUNC_LOC_GEN_ACTIVE        Bool: Is Autom. Creation of Functional Locations Active?    .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_NEIGHBORHOOD              Changes Neighborhood Fields                                 .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_RLRA                      Changes Representative List of Rents                        .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SETTL_VARIANTS            Changes Default Settlement Variants                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SINSTBEZ                  Changes Maintenance District                                .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SLAGEWE                   Changes the Number of the BE Location                       .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SMIETR                    Changes Tenancy Law                                         .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SOBJLAGE                  Changes Indicator for District Location of Object           .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SSTDORT                   Changes Regional Location                                   .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SVERKEHR                  Changes Transport Connection of BE                          .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_SWENR                     Changes Business Entity                                     .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_UNITS                     Changes Units of Measure                                    .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes Validity of Object                                  .
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_XNOTPL                    Changes'No automatic creation of functional location allowed.
IF_REBD_BUSINESS_ENTITY        I SET_XWETEXT                   Changes Business Entity Identification                      .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I ACCURATE_CHARACT              Select Fixt./Fittings Characteristic as Applicable          .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I ADD_CHARACT                   Add Fixtures and Fittings Characteristics                   .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I APPEND_DEFAULT                Adds the Default Characteristics                            .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I CHANGE_CHARACT                Change Fixtures and Fittings Characteristics                .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I CHECK_DATERANGE               Checks If Characteristics Allowed in Time Period            .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I CHECK_INTERSECTIONS           Checks Lists for Overlaps                                   .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I CHECK_RLRA                    Checks If Characteristics Are Correct for Rep. List of Rents.
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_CHARACT_ALLOWED           Supplies All Permitted Fixtures and Fittings Characteristics.
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_CHARACT_FOR_INSERT        Supplies All Available Fixtures and Fittings Characteristics.
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries with Additional Data                   .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_TEMPORARY_RLRA            Gets the Temporary Rep. List of Rents                       .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I REMOVE_CHARACT                Delete Fixtures and Fittings Characteristic                 .
IF_REBD_CHARACT_MNGR           I SET_TEMPORARY_RLRA            Sets the Temporary Rep. List of Rents                       .
IF_REBD_EQUIPMENT              I DISMANTLE                     Dismantle Equipment                                         .
IF_REBD_EQUIPMENT              I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_EQUIPMENT              I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REBD_EQUIPMENT              I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_EQUIPMENT              I INSTALL                       Install Equipment                                           .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I DISMANTLE_EQUIPMENT           Dismantle Equipment -" NOT YET                              .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_CLASSIFICATION_MNGR       Gets the Classification Manager                             .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I GET_REAL_TPLNR                Supplies Correct Internal Number (TPLNR) - Not TMP Number!  .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I INSTALL_EQUIPMENT             Install Equipment -" NOT YET                                .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I REFRESH                       Updates Functional Location from Database                   .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I SET_DETAIL                    Stores Structure with Basic Data                            .
IF_REBD_FUNC_LOC               I SET_LABEL                     Sets New Functional Location ID                             .
IF_REBD_HAS_CHARACT            I GET_CHARACT_MNGR              Supplies the Fixtures and Fittings Manager                  .
IF_REBD_HAS_INFRA              I GET_INFRA_MNGR                Gets the Infrastructure Manager                             .
IF_REBD_HAS_LOC_HIER           I GET_LOC_HIER_MNGR             Gets Hierarchical Location Structure Manager                .
IF_REBD_HAS_MEAS               I GET_MEAS_MNGR                 Supplies Measurement Manager                                .
IF_REBD_HAS_NODE               I GET_NODE_MNGR                 Supplies Measurement Manager                                .
IF_REBD_HAS_NUMBER             I GET_NUMBER_MNGR               Supplies Number Manager                                     .
IF_REBD_HAS_OBJREL             I GET_OBJREL_MNGR               Supplies Relationship Usage View-" Architecture Manager     .
IF_REBD_HAS_OBJREL             I SET_DATA_FROM_BUSOBJ          Adopts Data from Assigned Object                            .
IF_REBD_HAS_OBJ_ASSIGN         I GET_OBJ_ASSIGN_ALLOWED        Gets Allowed Object Types for the Assignment                .
IF_REBD_HAS_OBJ_ASSIGN         I GET_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR           Gets Object Assignment Manager (Categorized)                .
IF_REBD_HAS_OBJ_REL_RO         I GET_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR           Supplies Rental Object Relationship Manager                 .
IF_REBD_HAS_OCCUPANCY          I GET_OCCUPANCY_MNGR            Gets Occupancy Manager                                      .
IF_REBD_HAS_PM                 I GET_PM_MNGR                   Supplies Functional Location Manager                        .
IF_REBD_HAS_RO_MNGR            I GET_RO_MNGR                   Supplies Rental Object Manager for Dependent Instances      .
IF_REBD_HAS_VALID_PERIOD       I GET_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR         Gets the Object-Period Manager                              .
IF_REBD_HAS_VALID_PERIOD       I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes the Validity Period                                 .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I REFRESH                       Cleanup of Lists                                            .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_REBD_INFRA_MNGR             I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I CHECK_DELETE_ALLOWED          Checks If Deleting the Entry Is Allowed                     .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I CHECK_UPDATE_ALLOWED          Checks If Changing the Entry Is Allowed                     .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Entry                                                  .
IF_REBD_LOC_HIER_MNGR          I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I ADD_INITIAL_MEASUREMENTS      Adds Initial Measurements to Buffer                         .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I ADD_SLICE_LIST                Insert Available Measurements Using List                    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I CHANGE_SINGLE                 Changes Value for Single Measurement in Period              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I CHECK_KEY                     Checks a New Measurement                                    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I CHECK_MEAS_ALLOWED            Checks If Measurement Type Is Allowed on Object             .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I COUNT                         Delivers Number of Measurements                             .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I DELETE                        Removes a Measurement                                       .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Measurement                                         .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Measurement Exists (Y/N)                     .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I FIX_DATERANGES                Correct Time Periods Using Base Time Period from Parent     .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_CHANGES                   Delivers Changed Measurements                               .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_DEFAULT_MEASUREMENT       Supplies Main Measurement Type                              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL                    Delivers Individual Measurement                             .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL_X                  Delivers Individual Measurement with Text Fields            .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_DFL_WITH_DATE             Delivers Main Measurement for Key Date                      .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_DFL_WITH_RANGE            Delivers All Main Measurements for Period                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_INITIAL_MEASUREMENTS      Supplies Initial Measurements (Required, Optional, ...)     .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_INTERSECTIONS             Supplies Overlapping Measurements (Since Last Cons. Status) .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST                      Delivers All Measurements                                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST_AVAILABLE            Supplies Available (= Free) Measurement Amounts             .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST_COMPLETE             Supplies Capacity-Related Measurement Amounts               .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST_OCCUPIED             Supplies Unavailable (= Occupied) Measurement Amounts       .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST_SIMPLE               Supplies Measurements as "Simple" List                      .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_LIST_X                    Delivers All Measurements with Additional Data              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_MEAS_ALLOWED              Delivers All Permitted Measurement Types                    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_MEAS_FOR_INSERT           Delivers All Insertable Measurement Types                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_PARENT_VALIDITY           Supplies Start and End Date of Parent Object                .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_TEXT                      Delivers Standard Text of Measurement                       .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_VALUE_OUTPUT              Supplies Output Options for Measurement Values              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_WITH_DATE                 Delivers Measurement for Key Date (One or All)              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_WITH_RANGE                Delivers All Measurements for Key Date (One or All)         .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I HAS_INTERSECTIONS             Bool: Are There Overlaps?                                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INCREASE                      Increase an Available Measurement (From-To)                 .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INCREASE_LIST                 Increase Available Measurement Using List                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Measurement Manager via Superordinate Object    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New (Complete!) Measurement                         .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INSERT_DETAIL_SIMPLE          Inserts New Measurement                                     .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I INSERT_LIST                   Inserts New (Complete!) Measurements                        .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I IS_EDITABLE                   Can measurement be changed manually?                        .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I IS_MEAS_ALLOWED               Bool: Measurement Type Allowed on Object                    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I IS_MEAS_INVALID               Measurements Are Not Current (Registered)                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I RECALC_AVAILABLE              Recalculate Available Amount                                .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I RECALC_SET_ACTIVE             Sets Recalculation for REFRESH                              .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I REDUCE                        Reduce an Available Measurement (From-To)                   .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I REDUCE_LIST                   Reduce Available Measurement Using List                     .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I REFRESH                       Starts Recalculation of Measurements                        .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I REFRESH_ALLOWED_MEAS          Redetermine List of Allowed Measurements                    .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I SET_LIST                      Sets All Measurements                                       .
IF_REBD_MEAS_MNGR              I STAGGER_INTERSECTIONS         Stagger Overlaps Using Table                                .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I EXISTS_CHILD                  Checks Whether Lower-Level Objects Exist                    .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I EXISTS_PARENT                 Checks Whether Parent Object Exists                         .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_CHILD_NODES               Reads Subordinate Nodes of a Node                           .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_COMPLETE_NODE_HIERARCHY   Reads Complete Hierarchy of a Node (Up/Down)                .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_LEAVES                    Reads All End Nodes of Node of Hierarchy                    .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_NODE                      Reads VIBDNODE Table in Object Puffer                       .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_PARENT_NODE               Reads Higher-Level Nodes                                    .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_PARENT_NODE_AOTYPE        Reads Higher-Level Nodes of Certain Type                    .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I GET_ROOT_NODE                 Reads the Root Object for an Object                         .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_NODE_MNGR              I SET_PARENT                    Assigns Parent Object                                       .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I CHECK_AOTYPE                  Checks Individual Settings of Arch. Object Type             .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Number Range                                        .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I GET_ALLOWED_CHILDTYPES        Supplies Allowed Subordinate AO Types                       .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I GET_ALLOWED_PARENTTYPES       Supplies Allowed Superordinate AO Types                     .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I GET_MY_NUMRANGE               Supplies Number Assignment for Current Object               .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Number Range (Overwrites Existing)               .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I SET_DEFAULT_VALUES            Fills Table with Default Values                             .
IF_REBD_NUMBER_MNGR            I SET_LIST                      Writes Back All Entries                                     .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_ADJUSTNUMBER              Supplies the Status Number or Group Number                  .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_LIST_ENTRY                Supplies Entry for Object Manager                           .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I GET_XOBJGRP                   Supplies Object Group Name                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I SET_ADJUSTNUMBER              Changes the Status Number or Group Number                   .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Structure with Basic Data                           .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I SET_LIST_ENTRY                Sets Entry for Object Manager                               .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Sets Local Validity                                         .
IF_REBD_OBJECT_GROUP           I SET_XOBJGRP                   Changes Object Group Name                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I CHANGE_LINK                   Changes Period of Assignment                                .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I CHECK_LINK_POSSIBLE           Checks if "Src-"Dest" Link Possible                         .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I CHECK_UNLINK_POSSIBLE         Checks if "Src-"Dest" Link Can Be Removed                   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Lines in Current Relationship Table      .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_ARCH_OBJECTS              Supplies Arch. Objects for a Usage Object                   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_ARCH_OBJECT_DIRECT        Supplies 1:1 Assigned Arch. Object                          .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_LIST_REL_AO               Supplies Entries for Assigned Architecture                  .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_LIST_REL_PS_RS            Supplies Entries for Pooled Splaces "" Rental Spaces        .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_LIST_REL_UO               Supplies Entries for Assigned Usage Objects                 .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_RENTAL_SPACES             Supplies Rental Spaces of a Pooled Space                    .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_USAGE_OBJECTS             Supplies Usage Objects for an Arch. Object                  .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_USAGE_OBJECTS_FROM_AO     Supplies Usage Objects for an Arch. Object                  .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_USAGE_OBJECTS_HIERARCHY   Supplies Usage Objects for Hierarchy of an Arch. Object     .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I GET_USAGE_OBJECTS_SUB         Gets Usage Objects for Subordinate Hierarchy of AO          .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I HAS_AO_REL                    Does Link to Architecture Exist?                            .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I HAS_PS_REL                    Does Link From/To Pooled Space Exist?                       .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I HAS_UO_REL                    Does Link to Usage Exist?                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I IS_OBJECT_LINK_OLD            Checks if "Src-"Dest" Link is Old                           .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I LINK                          Creates Link Between Two Objects                            .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I PARENT_STORE_PREPARE          Execute ALL_STORE_PREPARE of Parent                         .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I PARENT_STORE_WRITE            Execute ALL_STORE_WRITE of Parent                           .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I REFRESH_PART                  Recalculate Assignment Shares Using Measurements            .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_COMPLETE                  Sets Relationship to "Complete" or "Partial"                .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_LIST_REL_MEAS             Sets Measurements of Link                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_MAINOBJECT                Sets "Main Object" Indicator                                .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_MEAS_FROM_RELPARTS        Sets Object Measurements Using Partial Assignment Amounts   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_RELPARTS_FROM_MEAS        Sets Partial Assignment Amounts Using Object Measurements   .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I SET_SUBOBJECT_MODE            Sets "Dependent Object" Indicator                           .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I TOUCH_OBJECT                  Adds Object to Change List                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJREL_MNGR            I UNLINK                        Removes Relationship Between Two Objects                    .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I BUFFER_RESET                  Resets Buffers                                              .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I CHECK_DELETE_ALLOWED          Checks If Deleting the Assignment Is Allowed (Message List) .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I CHECK_INSERT_ALLOWED          Checks If Adding the Entry Is Allowed (Exception)           .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I CHECK_UPDATE_ALLOWED          Checks If Changing the Entry Is Allowed (MSG List)          .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I DUPLICATE_DETAIL              Duplicates an Entry                                         .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_BUSOBJ                    Gets Object Instance Using Object Number                    .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_LIST_OLD                  Gets Old Entries (DB)                                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_OBJTYPES_ALLOWED          Gets Allowed Object Types                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_OBJTYPES_POSSIBLE         Gets Possible Object Types                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Entry                                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I IS_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORTED        Is a Given Attribute Possible in the Assignment?            .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I IS_DELETE_ALLOWED             Is Deleting a Given Assignment Allowed?                     .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I IS_EMPTY                      No Entry Exists?                                            .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I SET_ASSIGNONLYINFO            Sets Informational Indicator                                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I SWITCH_TEMP_OBJNR             Changes Temporary Object Numbers to Real Ones               .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_ASSIGNINFOIND             Gets Indicator for Informational Assignment                 .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_DETAIL_BO                 Gets Structure with Group                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_DETAIL_BO_X               Gets Structure with Group and Additional Data               .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_LIST_BO                   Gets All Entries with Groups                                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_LIST_BO_OLD               Gets Old Entries (DB) with Groups                           .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_LIST_BO_X                 Gets All Entries with Groups and Additional Data            .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_NEXT_GROUP_NUMBER         Gets Next Available Group Number                            .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_OBJECT_GROUP              Gets Object Group                                           .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_OBJECT_GROUPS             Gets All Object Groups                                      .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_OBJECT_GROUP_FOR_OBJECT   Gets Object Group Assignment for Object                     .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I GET_RENTOBJ_MNGR              Supplies Rental Object Manager                              .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I INSERT_BUS_OBJECT             Adds New Business Object                                    .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I INSERT_OBJECT_GROUP           Adds New Object Group                                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I IS_RESERVED                   Bool: Reservation Active?                                   .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I MOVE_OBJECT_TO_GROUP          Moves an Object to or from an Object Group                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I RENUMBER_GROUPS               Renumbering of Groups                                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_BO     I UPDATE_DETAIL_BO              Changes Entry (= Replaces with New)                         .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I ADD_FUNC_LOC_REL              Add Relationship to Functional Location                     .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I CHANGE_FUNC_LOC_REL           ES_OBJ_ASSIGN_PS_NEW Exporting Type REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_PS      .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I CHECK_FUNC_LOC_ASSIGNABLE     Checks If Functional Location Is Allowed to Be Assigned     .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I DELETE_FUNC_LOC_REL           Remove Relationship to Functional Location                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I GET_FUNC_LOC                  Supplies Functional Location Instance                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I GET_LIST_PM                   Gets All Entries (PM)                                       .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I GET_LIST_PM_X                 Gets All Entries (PM) Including Additional Data             .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I GET_NOTIFICATIONS             Gets All Notifications for Functional Location              .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I GET_RE_FUNC_LOC               Supplies RE Functional Location Instance                    .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I REFRESH                       Update of Functional Locations                              .
IF_REBD_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PM     I UPDATE_CLASSIFICATION         Updating of Classification of RE Functional Location        .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I ADD_OBJECT                    Add New Object to Relationship                              .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I CHECK_RELATION_RANGES         Checks If Time Periods in Basic Time Period                 .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I DEL_OBJECT                    Delete Object from Relationship                             .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I FIX_RELATIONS                 Correct Relations Based on Base Time Periods                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_OBJECT_INSTANCE           Supplies Instance for Object (Intreno) from Buffer          .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Supplies All Entries as Instance References                 .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_OBJ_REL_RO_MNGR        I RECALC_PART                   New Calculation of Shares Using the Measurements            .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I ADAPT_PAYMENT_TERM            Adjusts the Standard Posting Term                           .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I DELETE                        Removes Occupancy                                           .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I DELETE_DETAIL                 Removes Occupancy Using Key                                 .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I ENABLING_CONTEXT_CHANGED      Context of Occupancy Authorization Was Changed              .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Single Occupancy                                       .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Single Occupancy and Additional Data                   .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Gets All Occupancies                                        .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Gets All Occupancies and Additional Data                    .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Occupancy Manager Using Superordinate Object    .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New Occupancy                                       .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I INSERT_VACANCY                Adds Vacancy                                                .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I IS_PERIOD_VACANT              Is Period Vacant?                                           .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I SET_DETAIL_FOR_EVENT          Sets Vacancy for Event                                      .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Sets All Occupancies                                        .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Updates Occupancy                                           .
IF_REBD_OCCUPANCY_MNGR         I UPDATE_PAYMENT_TERM           Writes Template Term into Standard Posting Term             .
IF_REBD_PLAN_OCC               I GET_LIST                      Supplies Entries for Arch. Object                           .
IF_REBD_PLAN_OCC               I INIT_BY_ROOT_OBJECT           Initializes Object for Mass Processing per Root Object      .
IF_REBD_PLAN_OCC               I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Fills Class Attributes                                      .
IF_REBD_PLAN_PS                I GET_LIST                      Supplies Entries for Arch. Object                           .
IF_REBD_PLAN_PS                I INIT_BY_ARCH_OBJECT           Initializes Object for Mass Processing per Arch. Object     .
IF_REBD_PLAN_PS                I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Fills Class Attributes                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_ALLOWED_USAGE           Checks Allowed Usage Values                                 .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_BUILDING_PLAN           Checks Development Plan                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_DATES                   Checks Dates                                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_GEMEINDE                Checks Municipality Key                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_JERBBAU                 Checks Heritable Building Right Indicator                   .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_LAND_VALUES             Checks Land Values                                          .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_LEINS                   Checks Unit of Length                                       .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_NFLURNR                 Checks Parcel of Land                                       .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_REAL_USAGE              Checks Actual Usage Values                                  .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SGRART                  Checks Type of Property                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SGRFRM                  Checks Property Ground Type                                 .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SGRGZS                  Checks Overall Condition of Property                        .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SGRNR                   Checks Property Number of BE                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SGRQAL                  Checks Property: Quality of Location                        .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SUNUTZA                 Checks Main Usage Type                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Business Entity Number                               .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_USAGES                  Checks Usages Per Plan                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_XGEMARK                 Checks Local Subdistrict                                    .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_XGRTXT                  Checks Land Register Text                                   .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I CHECK_XNUTZGRU                Checks Current Usage                                        .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_ALLOWED_USAGE             Supplies Allowed Usage Values                               .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_AREA_UNIT                 Supplies Area Unit                                          .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_ASSET_ACCOUNTING_STATE    Supplies Status of Relationship to Fixed Asset              .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_BUSINESS_AREA             Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_BUSINESS_ENTITY           Supplies Business Entity (Object)                           .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_IMKEY                     Delivers Internal Key for Real Estate Object                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_LAND                      Supplies Parcels of Land                                    .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_LAND_VALUES               Supplies Land Value                                         .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_PROFIT_CENTER             Supplies Profit Center                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_RBEPLAN                   Supplies Development Plan                                   .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_REAL_USAGE                Supplies Actual Usage Values                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_RLRA                      Supplies Rep. List of Rents (BU)                            .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_SALEDATE                  Supplies (Planned) Sale Date                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Business Entity Number                             .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_TAX_JURISDICTION_CODE     Delivers Jurisdiction for Tax Calc. - Tax Jurisdiction Code .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I GET_USAGES                    Supplies Usage Types per Plan                               .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Bool: Subordinate Objects Exist                             .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_ALLOWED_USAGE             Changes Allowed Usage Values                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_DWIRTUB                   Changes Transfer Usage / Charges                            .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_GEMEINDE                  Changes Municipality Key                                    .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_JERBBAU                   Changes Heritable Building Right Indicator                  .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_LAND                      Changs Parcels of Land                                      .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_LAND_VALUES               Changes Land Values                                         .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_RBEPLAN                   Changes Development Plan                                    .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_REAL_USAGE                Changes Actual Usage Values                                 .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SALEDATE                  Changes (Planned) Sale Date                                 .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SGRART                    Changes Property Type                                       .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SGRFRM                    Changes Property Ground Type                                .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SGRGZS                    Changes Overall Condition of Property                       .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SGRNR                     Changes Property Number                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SGRQAL                    Changes Property: Quality of Location                       .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SUNUTZA                   Changes Main Usage Type                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_SWENR                     Changes Business Entity                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_USAGES                    Changes Usages per Plan                                     .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes Validity of Object                                  .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_XGEMARK                   Changes Local Subdistrict                                   .
IF_REBD_PROPERTY               I SET_XGRTXT                    Changes Text in Land Register                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CAN_CHANGE_CFPOSTINGFROM      Asks If 1st Posting Can Be Changed                          .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CAN_CHANGE_FIRSTPOSTING       Asks If Starting Date of Cash Flow Can Be Changed           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CAN_CUT_RENTAL_SPACES         Can Rental Spaces Be Created for Pooled Space?              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_ASSESSMENT_CONTRACT     Checks That There Are No Gaps Between Assessment Contracts  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_BUILDYEAR               Checks Year of Construction                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_CANBECOMMON             Checks Indicator: Common Usage Possible                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_CFPOSTINGFROM           Check Date of First Posting                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_COMMONOWNED             Checks Common Property Indicator                            .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_CURRENCY                Checks Currency                                             .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_CUT_RENTAL_SPACES       Checks If Rental Spaces Can Be Created for Pooled Space     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_DBEZU                   Checks Date of Initial Use                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_DWTVERM                 Checks Date: Subsequent Rental                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_FIRSTPOSTING            Checks Start Date of Cash Flow                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_FIXFITCATE              Checks Fixtures and Fittings Category                       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_HASCOP                  Checks If Current Occupancy Principle Used                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_JEIGWOHN                Checks Condominium Owners' Association                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_POOL_SPACE              Checks If Assignment to Pool Is Correct (only Rental Space) .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_PROPERTY_BUILDING       Checks Property or Building Number                          .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_PZUABSP                 Checks Increase or Reduction Relative to Rep. List of Rents .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_RENT_ADJUST             Checks Percentage Increase and Reason for Deviation         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_REPR_LIST_OF_RENTS      Checks Rental Table Data                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_RESERVATION_DATE        Checks Date: Reserved From and To                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_RLGESCH                 Checks Location on Floor                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_RLRA                    Checks Representative List of Rents                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_RLRALOC                 Checks Location Class                                       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_ROTYPE                  Checks Rental Object Type                                   .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SALTNR                  Checks Old Rental Unit Number                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SGEBT                   Checks Part of Building                                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SMENR                   Checks Rental Object Number                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SNUNR                   Checks External Usage Type of Rental Object                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SPOSINMSP               Checks the Base Value for Rep. Rents List Adjustment        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SSTCKBIS                Checks Top Floor of Rental Object                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SSTOCKW                 Checks Floor                                                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Business Entity Number                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I CHECK_XMETXT                  Checks Rental Object Text                                   .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I DELETE_SLICE_SPACE            Deletes Rental Space from Pooled Space                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR            Supplies Settlement Manager for External Settlement         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_BUILDING                  Gets Building (Object)                                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_BUILDYEAR                 Supplies Year of Construction                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_BUSINESS_AREA             Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_BUSINESS_ENTITY           Supplies Business Entity (Object)                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CASHFLOW_MNGR             Supplies the Cash Flow Manager                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CFPOSTINGFROM             Supplies Date of First Posting                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_COMMONOWNED               Gets Common Property Indicator                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CONTRACTS                 Gets Contracts Rental Object Is Assigned To                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CONTRACT_NEXT             Supplies Next Occupancy Contract                            .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CONTRACT_PREVIOUS         Supplies Previous Occupancy Contract                        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_COST_CENTER               Delivers Cost Center                                        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Currency Used for Rental Object                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_CUT_IN_CONTRACT           Gets Indicator 'Rental Space Was Extracted in Contract'     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_FIRSTPOSTING              Gets Start Date of Cash Flow                                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_HIER_INFO                 Supplies Info.on Hier. Relationsh., Esp. Rental/Pooled Space.
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_IMKEY                     Delivers Internal Key for Real Estate Object                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_POOL_SPACE                Gets Related Pooled Space (Only for Rental Spaces!)         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_PROFIT_CENTER             Supplies Profit Center                                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_PROPERTY                  Gets Property (Object)                                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_PROPERTY_BUILDING         Supplies Property or Building Number                        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_RLGESCH                   Supplies Location on Floor                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_RLRA                      Supplies Representative List of Rents                       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_RLRAFIXFITCATE            Supplies Fixtures and Fittings Category                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_RLRALOC                   Supplies Location Class                                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_ROTYPE_TEXT               Supplies Name of Rental Object Type                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_RPROZGRD                  Supplies Reason for Deviation of Percentage Increase        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SCCNPART_MNGR             Supplies Settlement Participation Generator                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SGEBT                     Supplies Part of Building                                   .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SLICE_SPACE               Generates New Rental Space from Pool with Same Values       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SSTCKBIS                  Supplies Top Floor of RO                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SSTOCKW                   Supplies Floor                                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Business Entity Number                             .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TAX_JURISDICTION_CODE     Delivers Jurisdiction for Tax Calc. - Tax Jurisdiction Code .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TERM_ADJUSTMENT_MNGR      Supplies Adjustment Term Manager (Terms)                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TERM_OCCUPANCY_MNGR       Gets Payment Rule Manager for Vacancy (Terms)               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TERM_PAYMENT_MNGR         Supplies Payment Rule Manager (Terms)                       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_TMP_DISPLAY_SMENR         Supplies Temporary Display Number                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_USAGECATE                 Gets the Usage Category                                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_USAGE_TYPE_INT            Supplies Category of Usage Type (Internal)                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_USESRLRA                  Gets Usage of Rep. List of Rents                            .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I GET_VACANCY_PERIODS           Supplies Vacancy Periods                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Bool: Subordinate Objects Exist                             .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I IS_BUILDING_CHANGEABLE        Bool: Building Modifiable?                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I IS_PROPERTY_CHANGEABLE        Bool: Property Modifiable?                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I IS_RELEASED                   Asks If Rental Object Is Released                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_BUILDYEAR                 Changes Year of Construction                                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_CANBECOMMON               Changes Indicator: Common Usage Possible                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_CFPOSTINGFROM             Changes Date of First Posting                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_COMMONOWNED               Changes Common Property Indicator                           .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_CURRENCY                  Changes Currency                                            .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_DBEZU                     Changes Date of Initial Use                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_DRESAB                    Changes Date: Reserved From                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_DRESBIS                   Changes Date: Reserved To                                   .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_DRESTAUR                  Changes Date of Reconstruction/Extensive Modernization      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_DWTVERM                   Changes Date: Subsequent Rental                             .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_FIRSTPOSTING              Changes Start Date of Cash Flow                             .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_HASCOP                    Changes "Uses Current Occupancy Principle"                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_JEIGWOHN                  Changes Condominium Owners Association                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_NEIGHBORHOOD              Changes Neighborhood Fields                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_OOLOCK                    Changes Offer Lock                                          .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_PERHOE                    Changes Percentage Increase                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_POOL_SPACE                Sets Assigned Pooled Space (Only for Rental Spaces!)        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_PPOSINMSP                 Changes Percentage for Assigning RU in Rep. Rents List Fld  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_PROPERTY_BUILDING         Changes Property or Building Number                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_PZUABSP                   Changes Increase or Reduction Relative to Rep. List of Rents.
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_RLGESCH                   Changes Location on Floor                                   .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_RLRA                      Changes Representative List of Rents                        .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_RLRAFIXFITCATE            Changes Fixtures and Fittings Category                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_RLRALOC                   Changes Location Class                                      .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_ROTYPE                    Changes Rental Object Type                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_RPROZGRD                  Changes Reason for Deviation from Increase Percentage       .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SALTNR                    Changes Old Rental Unit Number                              .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SGEBT                     Changes Part of Building                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SMENR                     Changes Rental Object Number                                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SNUNR                     Changes External Usage Type of Rental Object                .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SPOSINMSP                 Changes Base Value for Assigning RU in Rep. Rents List Fld  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SSTCKBIS                  Changes Top Floor of RO                                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SSTOCKW                   Changes Floor                                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_SWENR                     Changes Business Entity                                     .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_USESRLRA                  Changes Usage of Rep. List of Rents                         .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes Validity of Object                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_XMETXT                    Changes Text of Rental Object                               .
IF_REBD_RENTAL_OBJECT          I SET_XSTANDNR                  Changes Number of Garage/Parking Space                      .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I ADD_POOL                      Add Pool                                                    .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I DEL_POOL                      Remove Pool                                                 .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I GET_CREATED_RENTOBJ           Supplies All Created Rental Objects (Rental Spaces)         .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries (Rental Object Instances)              .
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I GET_RENTOBJ_BY_OBJNR          Supplies Rental Object (Rental Space) Based On Object Number.
IF_REBD_RENTOBJ_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I ADD_BUS_OBJECT                Add New Relationship (Business Object Instance)             .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I COUNT                         Supplies number of entries                                  .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I DEL_BUS_OBJECT                Remove New Relationship (Business Object Instance)          .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I DO_NOT_SAVE_OBJECT            Flag Instance of Object as "Do Not Save"                    .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries (Rental Object Instances)              .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I GET_LIST_NO_SAVE              Supplies All Instances that Are NOT Saved                   .
IF_REBD_RO_MNGR                I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I CHECK_CHANGE_POSSIBLE         Check If Change Is Allowed                                  .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I CHECK_VALID_PERIOD            Checks Validity Period of Object                            .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I GET_VALID_PERIOD              Gets the Validity of the Object [Final]                     .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I GET_VALID_PERIOD_WITH_PARENT  Compares Period with Parent Object [Final]                  .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I INHERIT_VALID_PERIOD          Inherit Validity Period from Superordinate Object           .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_INHERITANCE_POSSIBLE       Bool: Inheritance Not Possible (No Super. Object Exists)    .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_PERIOD_CHANGE_CRITICAL     Bool: Change of Validity Period Is Critical                 .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_VALIDFROM_INHERITED        Bool: From-Date Is Inherited from Superordinate Object      .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_VALIDTO_INHERITED          Bool: To-Date Is Inherited from Superordinate Object        .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_VALID_PERIOD_CHANGEABLE    Bool: Validity Period Is Directly Modifiable                .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I IS_VALID_PERIOD_INHERITED     Bool: Validity Period Is Inherited Completely from Sup.Obj. .
IF_REBD_VALID_PERIOD_MNGR      I SET_VALID_PERIOD              Changes the Valdity Period [Abstract]                       .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_02            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_02            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_02            I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_02            I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I COUNT                         Supplies number of entries                                  .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_REBF_TEMPLATE_03            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I ASSIGN_ADDRESS                Creates Address Assignment for Object                       .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I CHANGE_ADDRESS                Changes Address of Object                                   .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I DERIVE_ADDRESS                Derives Address Assignment for Object from Subordinate Obj. .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I GET_ADDRESS_ORIGIN            Origin of Address (SPACE = No Address Assigned)             .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I GET_ADRNR                     Supplies Address Number                                     .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Address Assignment for Object                      .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Address Assignment with Address for Object         .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I IS_DERIVATION_POSSIBLE        Bool: Derive (=Inherit) Addresses for Object Possible?      .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I REMOVE_ADDRESS                Cancels Address Assignment for Object                       .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I SHOW_ADDRESS                  Displays Address in Dialog Box                              .
IF_REBP_ADDRESS_MNGR           I STORE_PREPARE_EXTERNAL        Preparation for Save (Called Externally)                    .
IF_REBP_HAS_ADDRESS            I GET_ADDRESS_MNGR              Supplies Address Manager                                    .
IF_REBP_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS      I GET_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR        Gets Multiple Addresses Manager                             .
IF_REBP_HAS_PARTNER            I GET_PARTNER_MNGR              Business Partner Manager                                    .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I REFRESH                       Cleanup of Lists                                            .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I REGISTER_ADDRESS              Registers Address for Saving                                .
IF_REBP_MULTI_ADDRESS_MNGR     I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I CHECK_BANKDETAILID            Checks Existence of Bank Data ID for Partner                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_ADDRESS                   Gets Address                                                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_ADDRESS_IDENT             Supplies Address Identification                             .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_ADDRESS_PRINTFORM         Supplies Address Formatting for Printout                    .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_COMMUNICATION_DATA        Supplies Communication Data (E-Mail, Telephone, Fax)        .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Delivers Description of Partner for Compressed Output       .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_DETAIL_X                  Delivers Structures with Basic and Additional Data          .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_LANGU                     Delivers Language                                           .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I GET_SALUTATION                Delivers Salulation                                         .
IF_REBP_PARTNER                I SHOW_PRINTFORM                Dialog Box of Print Output                                  .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Consistency of VIBPOBJREL                            .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I CHECK_DETAIL_OWNER            Checks Consistency of Owner in Partner                      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks if Concrete Partner is Assigned on Key Date (Excep.) .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Partner-Object Relationship Via GUID                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I DELETE_DETAIL_BY_PARTNER      Deletes Partner-Object Relationship Via Partner/Role/Date   .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I EXISTS                        Checks if Concr. Partner is Assigned on Key Date (Y/N)      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I EXISTS_ANY_PARTNER            Checks If at Least 1 Partner is Assigned (Y/N)              .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I EXISTS_PARTNER                Checks Whether Concr. Partner Is Assigned (Y/N)             .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_DEFAULT_ADDRESS_FOR_ROLE  Gets Default Address for a Given Role                       .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_KEYDATE           Supplies All Partners on Key Date                           .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_PARTNER           Gets All Entries of Partner                                 .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_PERIOD            Supplies All Partners in Time Period                        .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_HIER_BY_KEYDATE      Supplies All Partners on Key Date includ. Object Hierarchy  .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_HIER_BY_PERIOD       Supplies All Partners Incl. Object Hierarchy in Time Period .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_OLD                  Gets Old Entries (DB)                                       .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_MAIN_PARTNER_BY_KEYDATE   Supplies Main Partner for the Key Date                      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_MAIN_PARTNER_BY_PERIOD    Supplies All Main Partners in the Time Period               .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_OBJTYPEDIFF               Gets Differentiation Criterion for Getting Possible Roles   .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_ROLES_ALLOWED             Gets All Allowed Roles                                      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_ROLES_NON_CREATE          Gets Roles for Which Creating a Partner Is Not Allowed      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I GET_ROLES_OBLIGATORY          Gets All Required Roles                                     .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I HAS_SUBROLE_ENTRIES           Is there at least one entry using role type?                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I HAS_TIMEDEP_ENTRIES           Is there at least one time-dependent entry?                 .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New Partner Object Relationship                     .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I PARTNER_WRITE                 Supplies Final Partner Numbers (BP Save)                    .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I SET_CONV_FACTOR               Changes Conversion Factor for Tenancy in Common             .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I SET_CONV_FACTOR_FOR_EACH_OWNERChanges Conv. Factor for Tenancy in Common of All Owners    .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I SET_ROLES_NON_CREATE          Sets Roles for Which Creating a Partner Is Not Allowed      .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Partner-Object Relationship Via GUID                .
IF_REBP_PARTNER_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL_BY_PARTNER      Changes Partner-Object Relationship Via Partner/Role/Date   .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I DELETE_CATEGORY               Deletes Entry with Additional Text                          .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_CATEGORIES_FOR_INSERT     Gets Allowed Categories for Additional Texts                .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I GET_TEXT_REF                  Gets Reference to Additional Text                           .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECA_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR   I INSERT_CATEGORY               Creates New Entry for Additional Text                       .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I CHECK_DELETE_WITHOUT_ARCHIVINGChecks If Deletion Without Archiving Is Allowed [Default]   .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I CHECK_DELETION_FLAG_DEL       Checks If Resetting Deletion Flag Is Allowed [Default]      .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I CHECK_DELETION_FLAG_SET       Checks If Setting Delation Flag Is Allowed [Default]        .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I DELETE                        Deletes Data from DB that Exists in Archive [final]         .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I DELETE_WITHOUT_ARCHIVING      Deletes Entire Business Object Without Archiving [final]    .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I INIT                          "Only for Factory Methods" [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I READ_INTO_BUFFER              Reads Exactly One Data Object from the Archive [final]      .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I SET_DELETION_IND              Sets the Deletion Indicator for the Data Objects [Abstract] .
IF_RECA_ARCHIVING_OBJECT       I WRITE                         Writes Data Objects to the Archive [final]                  .
IF_RECA_BDT_FRAME              I CHECK_ATTRIBUTES              Check Attributes for Mandatory                              .
IF_RECA_BDT_FRAME              I GET_XTYPE                     Gets Text: Type of Object (e.g. "Business Entity")          .
IF_RECA_BDT_FRAME              I INIT                          Fills Attributes of BDT Template                            .
IF_RECA_BDT_FRAME              I INIT_BY_BUSOBJ                Fill Additional Data Based on Business Object [Final]       .
IF_RECA_BDT_FRAME              I SET_FIXED_VARNR               Use Different Screen Sequence (Fixed)                       .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I CHECK_AUTH_GROUP              Checks Authorization Group                                  .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I DEQUEUE                       Removes Lock                                                .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I ENABLE_SOURCE_ACCESS          Allows Access to Locked Parts Through Sourse Object [Final] .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I ENQUEUE                       Sets Lock                                                   .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_AUTH_GROUP                Supplies Authorization Group                                .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_BUSDETAIL                 Supplies Bus.Obj. Structure with Basic Data [final]         .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_BUSDETAIL_X               Supplies Bus.Obj. Structure with Basic and Add. Data [final].
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_BUSKEY                    Supplies Business Object Key (BOR-Key) [abstract]           .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_BUSTYPE                   Supplies Business Object Type (BOR Type) [abstract]         .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_CHANGE_DOCUMENT_IDENT     Supplies Object ID for Change Documents                     .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_CI_DATA                   Supplies Data of CI Include                                 .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_IDENT                     Supplies Object Identification                              .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_IMKEY                     Supplies Internal Key                                       .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_OBJTYPEDIFF               Gets Differentiating Criterion                              .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_PARENT_OBJECT             Supplies Higher-Level Business Object                       .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Supplies Responsible User                                   .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_RUSER                     Supplies User Data [abstract]                               .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_STORE_DATE                Supplies Time Stamp of STORE to Database [Final]            .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_SUB_OBJECTS               Supplies Higher-Level Business Objects                      .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_SWENR                     Gets the Number of the Related Business Entity              .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text [abstract]                           .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Supplies User with Exclusive Change Authorization           .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I GET_VALID_PERIOD              Supplies Object Validity                                    .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I HAS_SUBOBJECTS                Asks If There Are Subordinate Objects                       .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I INIT_BUS_OBJECT               "Only for Factory Methods" [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I IS_SOURCE_ACCESS_ENABLED      Is Access to Locked Parts Allowed [Final]                   .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I IS_VALID_IN_PERIOD            Asks If Object Is Valid [Final]                             .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I SET_AUTH_GROUP                Changes Authorization Group                                 .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I SET_CI_DATA                   Changes Data of CI Include                                  .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I SET_RESPONSIBLE               Changes Responsible User                                    .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I SET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Changes User with Exclusive Change Authorization            .
IF_RECA_BUS_OBJECT             I SUBSTITUTE                    Adds Data via Implemented Enhancements [Final]              .
IF_RECA_CUST_CHECK             I CHECK                         Check Customizing Settings                                  .
IF_RECA_HAS_ADDITIONAL_TEXT    I GET_ADDITIONAL_TEXT_MNGR      Gets Additional Text Manager                                .
IF_RECA_HAS_FORMULA            I EXISTS_FORMULA_VARIABLE       Checks If the Variable Exists                               .
IF_RECA_HAS_FORMULA            I GET_FORMULA_VALUE             Gets Value for Variables                                    .
IF_RECA_HAS_FORMULA            I SET_FORMULA_VALUE             Sets the Value for Variables                                .
IF_RECA_HAS_REGISTRATION       I GET_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR          Gets Registration Receiver Manager                          .
IF_RECA_HAS_REGISTRATION       I GET_RG_SENDER_MNGR            Gets Registration Trigger Manager                           .
IF_RECA_HAS_RESUBM             I GET_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR          Gets the Resubmission Date Manager                          .
IF_RECA_HAS_RESUBM             I GET_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR          Gets the Resubmission Rule Manager                          .
IF_RECA_HAS_STATUS             I GET_STATUS_MNGR               Supplies Status Manager                                     .
IF_RECA_HAS_TEXT               I GET_TDNAME_PREFIX             Supplies Prefix for Text Module Names (with temporary no.)  .
IF_RECA_HAS_TEXT               I GET_TEXT_MNGR                 Supplies Text Manager                                       .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I ADD                           Adds Message                                                .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I ADD_FROM_BAPI                 Adds All Messages from BAPI Format                          .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I ADD_FROM_INSTANCE             Inserts All Messages of Another Log                         .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I ADD_SYMSG                     Adds Message from SY-MSG* Variables                         .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I CHANGE_MSG_TYPE               Changes Type of Message, e.g. from E to W                   .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I CLEAR                         Deletes All Collected Messages                              .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I COUNT                         Gets Number of Messages                                     .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I DELETE_MESSAGE                Deletes Individual Message                                  .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I FREE                          Releases Resources of Instance                              .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_CALLBACK_DATA             Fill Callback Data from Message                             .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_FIRST_MESSAGE             Supplies First Message                                      .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_HANDLE                    Supplies Internal Log Handle                                .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_LAST_MESSAGE              Supplies Last Message                                       .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Collected Messages                             .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_LIST_AS_BAPIRET           Supplies All Collected Messages as a BAPI Error             .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Collected Messages with Additional Techn.Fields.
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_STATISTICS                Supplies Summary of Number of Messages, etc.                .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I GET_STATISTICS_AS_TEXT        Gets Summary as Text Using Message Number                   .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I HAS_MESSAGES_OF_MSGTY         Are There Messages of a Given Type (I; W; E; A)?            .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I INIT                          "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I INIT_BY_HANDLE                "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I INSERT                        Inserts Message at a Given Position                         .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I IS_EMPTY                      Is the List of Collected Messages Empty?                    .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I RAISE_EVENT_ON_SELECT         Triggers ON_SELECT Event                                    .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I RAISE_FIRST_MESSAGE           Gets First Message as Exception                             .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I SET_DETAIL_LEVEL              Changes Level of Detail for Following Messages              .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I SET_EXTNUMBER                 Changes External Identification of Log                      .
IF_RECA_MESSAGE_LIST           I STORE                         Saves Log with Collected Messages                           .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I CHANGE_PROCESSMODE            Changes Settlement Method                                   .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I DO_CANCEL_PERFORM             Interrupts Execution of Further Steps                       .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I ENABLE_STATUSBAR              Switches Status Display On/Off                              .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_DEP_STEPS4PERFORM         Which Settlement Steps Have to Be Carried Out               .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_DEP_STEPS4REVERSAL        Which Settlement Steps Have to Be Reversed                  .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_IMPLSUBTYPE4STEP          Supplies Implementation Name for Process Step               .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_LIST_EXECUTEABLE_STEPS    Supplies All Possible Executable Settlement Steps           .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_LIST_POSSIBLE_STEPS       Supplies All Possible Settlement Steps                      .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_LIST_REVERSEABLE_STEPS    Supplies All Possible Reversable Settlement Steps           .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_NEXT_POSSIBLE_STEP        Supplies Next Possible Settlement Step                      .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_PROCESSGUID               Supplies Process ID Manager                                 .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement                                .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_STEPTEXT                  Supplies Text for Settlement Step                           .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I GET_STEP_BY_TYPE              Supplies Reference to Instance of Required Step             .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I IS_CANCEL_PERFORM             Asks If Interruption of Execution Is Set                    .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I IS_STATUSBAR_ENABLED          Asks If Status Display Is Active                            .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I IS_STEP_EXECUTEABLE           Is Settlement Step Executable/Startable                     .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I IS_STEP_SELECTABLE            Is Settlement Step Selectable for Menu                      .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I IS_STORABLE                   Can Process Data Be Saved?                                  .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I REVERSAL_STEP                 Undo Up To One Settlement Step                              .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I RUN_MULTIPLE_STEPS            Execute Several Settlement Steps [Final]                    .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROCESS      I RUN_SINGLE_STEP               Execute Settlement Step                                     .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROC_PARAM   I CHANGE_PROCESSMODE            Changes Settlement Method                                   .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROC_PARAM   I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Parameters                                           .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROC_PARAM   I SET_MODE_AND_TYPE             Set Process Mode and Type of Process                        .
IF_RECA_MULTISTEP_PROC_PARAM   I SET_SAVEABLE_FLAG             Changes Indicator Allowing Saving (Depending on Mode)       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I GET_RUNTIME                   Supplies the Runtime                                        .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I GET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Supplies User with Exclusive Change Authorization           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I IS_REVERSE_ALLOWED            Is Reversal At All Possible                                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I PERFORM                       Execute [Final]                                             .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I REVERSAL                      Process Is Reversed - Selection on DB Table                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I SET_MODIFIED                  Data Was Changed by External Calling Program                .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I SET_PROCESSMODE               Sets the Process Mode                                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I SET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Changes User with Exclusive Change Authorization            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I STORE_MSGLIST                 Saves the Message List                                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS                I STORE_PROCESS                 Saves Changes Persistently [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_HAS_STATUS     I GET_STATUS_MNGR               Supplies Status Manager                                     .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I CHECK                         Checks the Parameter                                        .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I CREATE_PROCESSID              Generates ID of Process                                     .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I GET_GENERATED_EXTID           Generates and Supplies an External ID                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I GET_PARAM_LIST                Gets the Parameter List                                     .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I GET_PROCESSID                 Gets ID of Process                                          .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I GET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Supplies User with Exclusive Change Authorization           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance via Process Basic Data                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I INIT_BY_PROCESS               Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I REVERSAL                      Process Is Reversed - Selection on DB Table                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_DETAIL_BY_GUID            Load Process Basic Data via Process GUID                    .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_DETAIL_BY_ID              Load Process Basic Data                                     .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_EXTID                     Sets External Process ID                                    .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_MSGEXTNUMBER              Set Reference to Application Log                            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_PARAM_LIST                Transfer of Parameter List                                  .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_PROCESSID                 Setting of New Process ID                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_PROCESSMODE               Simulation or Update Runs                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_TITLE                     Sets Title of Process                                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_PARAM          I SET_USER_EXCLUSIVE            Changes User with Exclusive Change Authorization            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I GET_OBJSTATUS                 Gets the Status for a Given Object                          .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement Step                           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I REVERSAL                      Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I SET_OBJSTATUS                 Sets the Status for a Given Object                          .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STATUS_MNGR    I SET_STATUS                    Resets Status of Settlement Step                            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I DELETE_MESSAGES               Deletes Messages Related to This Step                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_DEPENDENT_STEPS           Which Settlement Steps Have To Be Carried Out First         .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_IMPLSUBTYPE4SUBSTEP       Supplies Implementation Name for Process Substep            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_MESSAGES                  Delivers Messages On Step                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_OBJGUID_LIST              Gets All Object IDs Used in Step                            .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement Step                           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_SUBSTEPS                  Delivers Sub-Settlement Steps                               .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_SUBSTEP_BY_TYPE           Gets a Given Sub-Step of Settlement                         .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_TEXT_FOR_STATUS_BAR       Gets the Text for the Status Line                           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I GET_VALUES                    Returns Values Determined                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I IS_EXECUTEABLE                Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I IS_REVERSE_ALLOWED            Is Reversal At All Possible                                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I IS_SELECTABLE                 Can Be Selected                                             .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I LOAD_ENTRIES                  Load Data When Step Is Called Again                         .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I PERFORM                       Execution of Step [Final]                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I PERFORM_SUBSTEPS              Execution of Settlement Substeps [Final]                    .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I REVERSAL                      Undo Settlement Step [Final]                                .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I RUN_SINGLE_SUBSTEP            Execute a Settlement Substep                                .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I SET_PARAM                     Sets the Parameter from Outside                             .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP           I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status of the Settlement Step                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I CHECK                         Check of the Parameter                                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I INIT_BY_TYPE                  Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I REVERSAL                      Delete All Parameters [Final]                               .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_STEP_PARAM     I SET_OBJGUID_LIST              Transfer of All Objects to Be Processed                     .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I DELETE_MESSAGES               Deletes Messages Related to This Step                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I GET_MESSAGES                  Delivers Messages On Step                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement Step                           .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I IS_EXECUTEABLE                Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I IS_REVERSE_ALLOWED            Is Reversal At All Possible                                 .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I LOAD_ENTRIES                  Load Data When Step Is Called Again                         .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I PERFORM                       Execution of Step [Final]                                   .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I REVERSAL                      Undo Settlement Step [Final]                                .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP        I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status of the Settlement Step                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP_PARAM  I INIT_BY_TYPE                  Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP_PARAM  I REVERSAL                      Delete All Parameters                                       .
IF_RECA_PROCESS_SUBSTEP_PARAM  I SET_OBJGUID_LIST              Transfer of All Objects to Be Processed                     .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I CALCULATE_ALL                 Calculates List of Dates for All Resub. Rules (Refresh)     .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I CALCULATE_DATE_LIST           Calculates List of Dates for a Resubmission Rule            .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I DELETE_DATE_LIST              Deletes List of Dates                                       .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_CHANGES                   Gets Changed Data                                           .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_INFO_BY_NOTE              Gets Infotext with Beginning of Memo                        .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I SET_DONE                      Sets 'Completed' Status                                     .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I SET_FIXED                     Sets 'Firmly Planned' Status                                .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I SET_WFEVENT                   Sets 'Send Workflow Event' Status                           .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR       I UPDATE_INFO_BY_NOTE           Updates Infotext with Beginning of Memo                     .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Resubmission Rule                                   .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I EXISTS_ANY_RULE               Checks If at Least One Resubmission Rule Exists             .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_RESUBM_DATE_MNGR          Gets the Resubmission Date Manager                          .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I GET_RULES_FOR_INSERT          Gets All Resubmission Rules That Can Be Inserted            .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Creates New Resubmission Rules                              .
IF_RECA_RESUBM_RULE_MNGR       I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Resubmission Rule                                   .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I EXISTS_ANY_RECEIVER           Checks If at Least One Registration Receiver Exists         .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I EXISTS_ANY_RECEIVER_TO_CONFIRMChecks If Registration Receiver Exists Needing Confirmation .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_LIST_BY_RGREASON          Gets All Entries for Registration Reason Entered            .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_LIST_BY_RGSTATE           Gets All Entries for Object State Entered                   .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RECA_RG_RECEIVER_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New Registration Receiver                           .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I DELETE_BY_RGSTATE             Deletes All Entries for Object State Entered                .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Registraction Entry                                 .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I EXISTS_ANY_SENDER             Checks If at Least One Registration Trigger Exists          .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_BY_RGSTATE         Gets 1st Entry for Object State Entered                     .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_LIST_BY_RGSTATE           Gets All Entries for Object State Entered                   .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_LIST_FOR_WORKLIST         Gets All Entries for Worklist                               .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RECA_RG_SENDER_MNGR         I UPDATE_RESPONSIBLE            Updates Person Responsible According to Business Object     .
IF_RECA_RG_STATE               I GET_RG_LIST_X                 Gets the Registration Entries (Ungbuffered) [final]         .
IF_RECA_RG_STATE               I INIT                          "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RECA_RG_STATE               I UPDATE_RECEIVER_BY_BUSOBJ     Updates Registration Receiver Using Reference [final]       .
IF_RECA_RG_STATE               I UPDATE_RECEIVER_BY_OBJNR      Updates Registration Receiver Using OBJNR [final]           .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I GET_SEARCH_STRATEGY           Gets Search Strategy (If Unique or Already Set)             .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I GET_SEARCH_STRAT_VALUES       Gets Values for Search Strategy                             .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I GET_TEXT                      Gets Text for a Value of Current Field                      .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I GET_TEXT_FOR_RESULT           Gets the Texts for a Transferred Search Result              .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I GET_VALUE_OTHERS              Returns the Value for "Other Values" (Standard Search Help) .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I HAS_SHSTRAT                   T/F: Is Search Strategy Set/Found for Search Field?         .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I HAS_VALID_SHSTRAT             T/F: Was a Valid Search Strategy Set for Search Field?      .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I INIT                          Initializes New Instance of Search Field                    .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I INIT_BEFORE_STANDARD_SH       Sets Search-Field-Specific Environ., If No Search Strategy  .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I IS_POPUP                      T/F: Should Result of Search Be Displayed as Popup?         .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I IS_VALID_VALUE                T/F: Is Entered Field Value Allowed by Search Strategy?     .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I SET_FIELD_STATE_POPUP         Set Explicitly: Display Listbox as Popup/Dropdown           .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I SET_SEARCH_STRATEGY           Sets Search Strategy (If Assigned from Outside)             .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_FIELD           I SET_VALUES_FOR_DROPDOWN       Sets Dropdown Values for the Screen                         .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_METHOD          I GET_SEARCH_STRAT_VALUES       Gets Values for Search Strategy                             .
IF_RECA_SEARCH_METHOD          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes New Instance of Search Field                    .
IF_RECA_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I GET_PARAM_SPECIFIC_CODE       Gets a Character String for Each Parameter [Abstract]       .
IF_RECA_STATIC_EVENT_HANDLER   I SET_HANDLER                   Registers the Event Handler                                 .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I CHECK_TRANSACTION_ALLOWED     Checks If a Given Action Is Allowed                         .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I CREATE_OBJNR                  Supplies New Object Number [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I CREATE_STATUS_OBJECT          Creates New Status Object (If Necessary)                    .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I DO_TRANSACTION                Executes Transaction                                        .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I EXISTS_STATUS_OBJECT          Does a Status Object Exist?                                 .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_CURRENT_OBJNR             Supplies Current Object Number (Real or Temporary)          .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_CURRENT_STATUS            Supplies Current Status                                     .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_CURRENT_STATUS_X          Gets Current Status with Text                               .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_CURRENT_TRANSACTIONS      Supplies Next/Previous Transaction                          .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_OLD_STATUS                Gets Status (DB Status)                                     .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_STATUS_PROFILE            Supplies Status Schema                                      .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_STATUS_PROFILE_DEFAULT    Supplies Default Status Profile for This Object             .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_TEXT_LINES                Supplies 4 character status as text lines with length 40    .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I GET_TRANSACTIONS              Supplies Possible Transactions for Object                   .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object [Final]          .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_ACCOUNT_ASSIGNMENT_LOCKED  Asks If the Account Assignment Is Locked                    .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_DELETION_FLAG_SET          Asks If Deletion Flag Is Set                                .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_DELETION_INDICATOR_SET     Asks If Deletion Indicator Is Set                           .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_MASTER_DATA_LOCKED         Asks if master data lock is set                             .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_STATUS_INTERNAL            Checks If Status Is Internal (=System Status)               .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I IS_TRANSACTION_ALLOWED        Is Activity Allowed?                                        .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I SET_STATUS                    Sets 'transferred' status                                   .
IF_RECA_STATUS_MNGR            I SET_STATUS_PROFILE            Sets a Status Profile for the Current Object                .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I ADD_CHILD                     Inserts a Subobject [final]                                 .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I CHECK_ALL                     Checks All Data [Final]                                     .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I FREE                          Releases all resources and locks [Final]                    .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I GET_CHILDREN                  Supplies All Subobjects Inserted with ADD_CHILD [Final]     .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I GET_CHILDREN_EXT              Gets All Enhanced Subobjects [Final]                        .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I GET_EXTENSION                 Supplies Instance with Enhancements [Final]                 .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I GET_FIELDSTATUS               Gets Data Structure Fields for the Field Status [Final]     .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I INIT_BY_TEMPLATE              Initialization of Data via Template Object [Final]          .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I IS_FIELDSTATUS_SET            Gets the Field Status for a Given Field [Final]             .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I IS_MODIFIED                   Checks if data was changed [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I IS_OK                         Checks If There Are Errors or Warnings [Final]              .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I IS_TEMPLATE_SUBTYPE           Checks for Differentiating Char. when Creating w/ Template  .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I REGISTER_ALL_CHILDREN         Registers All Subobjects [Final]                            .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I RELEASE                       Removes Locks [Final]                                       .
IF_RECA_STORABLE               I STORE                         Saves Changes Persistently [Final]                          .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I CHECK_ALL                     Checks All Data                                             .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I FREE                          Releases all resources and locks                            .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes the Data via Superordinate Object               .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I INIT_BY_TEMPLATE              Initializes the Data Using a Template Object                .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I IS_MODIFIED                   Checks for Changed Data                                     .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I STORE_PREPARE                 Prepares for Saving                                         .
IF_RECA_STORABLE_EXT           I STORE_WRITE                   Calls the Update Task Modules                               .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I GET_NEXT_PACKAGE              Gets Data Packet                                            .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I GET_PARAM                     Gets Task-Specific Parameters                               .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I GET_PARAM_FOR_RFC             Gets Task-Relevant Data as INDX                             .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I INIT                          Initializes the Task                                        .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I INIT_FOR_RFC                  Initializes Task for RFC                                    .
IF_RECA_TASK                   I RUN                           Performs Task                                               .
IF_RECA_TASK_HANDLER           I COLLECT_RESULT                Collects Results of Individual Tasks                        .
IF_RECA_TASK_HANDLER           I GET_NEXT_PACKAGE              Gets Next Package                                           .
IF_RECA_TASK_HANDLER           I GET_NEXT_TASKNUMBER           Gets Next Number for Task                                   .
IF_RECA_TASK_HANDLER           I GET_USER_PARAM                Gets Task-Specific Parameters                               .
IF_RECA_TASK_HANDLER           I START_TASKS                   Starts Parallel Processing                                  .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I ADOPT_DATA_BY_OTHER           Adopts Text Module Contents from Other Instance             .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I DELETE_TEXT                   Deletes Text Module Contents                                .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I GET_HEADER                    Gets the Text Header                                        .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I GET_TEXT_AS_ITF               Supplies Text in Text Module Format (with Format Column)    .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I GET_TEXT_AS_STREAM            Supplies Text as Stream with Format Characters              .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I INIT                          Initializes Text via Text Module Key                        .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I INIT_BY_OTHER                 Initializes Text with Data of Other Text                    .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I IS_EMPTY                      Is text blank?                                              .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I SET_HEADER                    Changes the Text Header                                     .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I SET_TDNAME                    Changes the Text Module Name (Only for Create Mode)         .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I SET_TEXT_AS_ITF               Changes Text in Text Module Format (with Format Column)     .
IF_RECA_TEXT                   I SET_TEXT_AS_STREAM            Changes Text as Stream with Format Characters               .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Text Module with Text Exists (Except.)            .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Text Modules                             .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I DELETE_TEXT                   Deletes Text Module Contents                                .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I EXISTS                        Checks If Text Module with Text Exists (Y/N)                .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Text Modules (References)                      .
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Reference to Text Object (Also for Empty Text Mods).
IF_RECA_TEXT_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Partial Key of Text Modules         .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I ADD_ENTRY                     Adds New Entry                                              .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I ADD_MORE_BUTTON               Adds "More" Button                                          .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I ADD_SIMPLE_TEXT_ENTRY         Adds Simple Text Entry                                      .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I CHANGE_ENTRY                  Changes an Entry in the Display                             .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I DELETE_ENTRY                  Removes Entry from Display                                  .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I DO_WB_REQUEST_IN_PAI          Buffer WB Request and Execute in PAI                        .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I END_DISPLAY                   Ends Building of New Display                                .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I EXPAND_ENTRY                  Expand to Level x                                           .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I GET_ENTRY_BY_ID               Gets Browser Entry Using ID                                 .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I GET_PARENT_ENTRY              Gets Superordinate Browser Entry (Using ID)                 .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I GET_TOP_ID                    Gets ID of Top Node                                         .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I IS_ENTRY_EXPANDED             Entry Expanded?                                             .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I REFRESH_DISPLAY               Completely Refresh Display                                  .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I REFRESH_ENTRY                 Update an Entry in Display                                  .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I REMOVE_MORE_BUTTON            Remove "More" Button                                        .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I REMOVE_WBOBJECT               Remove WB Object from Browser                               .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I SEARCH_SUBTYPE                Searches for Subtype Nodes of an Object in Browser          .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I SEARCH_WBOBJECT               Searches for WB Object in Browser                           .
IF_RECA_WB_BROWSER_DISPLAY     I START_DISPLAY                 Starts Building New Display                                 .
IF_RECA_WB_NAVIGATOR_TOOL      I INITIALIZE                    Initialize (Set Control)                                    .
IF_RECA_WB_STACK_ENTRY         I GET_STACK_ELEMENT             Returns Stack Element                                       .
IF_RECA_WB_STACK_ENTRY         I SET_STACK_ELEMENT             Sets Stack Element                                          .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I DO_WB_REQUEST                 Processing for a Workbench Request                          .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I GET_CURRENT_REQUEST           Returns Current Request and Additional Data                 .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I GET_CURRENT_WB_OBJECT         Gets Current WB Object of Tool                              .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I IS_REQUEST_INTERNAL           Checks If Superordinate Request Stays in Object             .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I PREPARE_FOR_EXIT              Prepare for Exiting Tool (with Save, ...)                   .
IF_RECA_WB_TOOL                I SET_DARK                      Sets Background Flag                                        .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I BROWSER_NODE_ADD              Browser: Display Object in Browser                          .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I BROWSER_NODE_EXPAND           Browser: Expand Nodes                                       .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I BROWSER_NODE_EXPAND_MORE      Browser: Expand Nodes Further                               .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I BROWSER_NODE_UPDATE           Browser: Update Object in Browser                           .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Returns Context Menu for Node                               .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I GET_ICON                      Gets Default Icon                                           .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I GET_IDENT                     Gets Text and ID of Object                                  .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I HANDLE_CONTEXT_COMMAND        Handler: Context Menu Selected                              .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I HANDLE_DOUBLE_CLICK           Handler: Double Click                                       .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I HANDLE_DRAG                   Handler: Object Should Be Dragged (Fill Data)               .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I HANDLE_DROPED                 Handler: Other Object Was Dropped Here                      .
IF_RECA_WB_TREE_NODE           I HANDLE_SHOW_PARENT            Handler: Display Superordinate List                         .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I CAN_DISTRIBUTE                Can Calculation Formula Distribute? (Algorithm)             .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I CAN_RECIPIENT_OR_SENDER       Supports Receiver or Sender?                                .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I CAN_SEND_MSG_EMPTY_DIST       Send a Message for an Empty Distribution?                   .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I CHECK_PARAMETER               Checks If Transferred Parameter Allowed                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I EXISTS_PARAMETER              Checks If Parameters Exist                                  .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_ALLOWED_OBJTYPE           Gets Allowed Object Types                                   .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_CUSTOMIZING_MOD           Supplies Modification Indic.-Customizing for the Parameter  .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_DEFAULT_PARAMETER         Gets Default Parameter                                      .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_GUI_PARAMETER_FUNCTION    Gets Modules for Parameter Maintenance                      .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_INFO_ID                   Gets ID for Information                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_DESCRIPTION     Supplies Parameter Description                              .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_INFO            Supplies Descriptive Text for a Parameter                   .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_LIST            Supplies a List of All Possible Parameters                  .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_UNIT                      Supplies the Unit of the Unit Price                         .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_VALUES                    Supplies the Calculation Amounts                            .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I GET_VALUE_UNIT                Supplies Unit of Calculation Amounts                        .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_ADJUSTABLE_BY_PROCESS      Adjustable by Adjustment Process?                           .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_BADI_RULE                  Ask If It Is a BAdI Formula?                                .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_DEPEND_RULE                Is Formula a Dependent Formula?                             .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_DISTRIBUTION_ALLOWED       Should Calculation Formula Distribute? (Customizing)        .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_DISTRIBUTION_LOCKED        Should Distribution Be Locked? (Algorithm)                  .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_INTERN                     Is It an Internal Formula?                                  .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_MODIFIABLE                 Can the Data Be Modified?                                   .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_MULTI_UNIQUE_VALUES        Calculates Multiple One-Time Amounts =" One-Time Condition? .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_OBJECT_NECESSARY           Is the calculation object needed?                           .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_PARAMETER_CHECK            Asks If the Parameters Should Be Checked                    .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_UNIQUE_VALUES              Calculates One-Time Amounts =" One-Time Condition?          .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I IS_UNITPRICE_ENABLED          Is Unit Price Needed?                                       .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I NEED_OBJECT_DATA              Is Object Data Needed for Calculation?                      .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I ROUND_CONDITION_AMOUNT        Rounds the Transferred Condition Amount per Customizing     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I ROUND_UNITPRICE               Rounds the Transferred Unit Price per Customizing           .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_DISTRIBUTION_ALLOWED      Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_INTERN                    Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_MODIFY                    Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_PARAMETER1                Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_PARAMETER2                Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CALC_RULE              I SET_RULE                      Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I CHANGE_OBJECT                 Changes the Object in OCF and PCF                           .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I CHECK_ANY_DELETION_IND_ALLOWEDChecks If Deletion Ind. Allowed for At Least One Act.Record .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY_OBJ                 Checks If Entry Is in Object-Related Cash Flow (Excep.)     .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY_PAY                 Checks If Entry Is in Payment-Related Cash Flow (Excep.)    .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries in Both Cash Flows               .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_ARCHIVED                Counts Archived Entries                                     .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_ARCHIVED_OBJ            Counts Archived OCF Entries                                 .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_ARCHIVED_PAY            Counts Archived PCF Entries                                 .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_OBJ                     Supplies Number of Entries in Object-Related Cash Flow      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_OBJ_OLD                 Supplies Number of Entries in 'Old' Object-Related Cash Flow.
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_PAY                     Supplies Number of Entries in Payment-Related Cash Flow     .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I COUNT_PAY_OLD                 Supplies No. of Entries in 'Old' Payment-Related Cash Flow  .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I DELETE_OBJ                    Deletes Entry from OCF                                      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I DELETE_PAY                    Deletes Entry from PCF                                      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I DELETE_PLAN                   Deletes All Planned Items                                   .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists for Any Cash Flow (Y/N)              .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_ARCHIVED               Checks If There Are Archived Entries                        .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_ARCHIVED_OBJ           Checks If There Are Archived OCF Entries                    .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_ARCHIVED_PAY           Checks If There Are Archived PCF Entries                    .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_OBJ                    Checks If Entry Exists for Object-Related Cash Flow (Y/N)   .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_OBJ_OLD                Checks If Entry Exists for 'Old' Obj.-Related Cash Flow(Y/N).
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_PAY                    Checks If Entry Exists for Payment-Related Cash Flow (Y/N)  .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I EXISTS_PAY_OLD                Checks If Entry Exists for 'Old'Pmnt-Related Cash Flow (Y/N).
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GENERATE_CASHFLOW             Generates the Cash Flows                                    .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_ARCHIVED_LIST_OBJ_X       Gets All Archived Entries for OCF Including Add. Data       .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_ARCHIVED_LIST_PAY_X       Gets All Archived Entries for PCF Including Add. Data       .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_BOOKING_CONTEXT           Supplies Posting Data for Cash Flows                        .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_OBJ                Supplies OCF Item for Key                                   .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_OBJ_X              Supplies Detail OCF Item for Key                            .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_PAY                Supplies PCF Item for Key                                   .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_PAY_X              Supplies Detail PCF Item for Key                            .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_OBJ                  Supplies All Entries for Object-Related Cash Flow           .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_OBJ_BY_PAYGUID       Gets All Entries for OCF That Belong to PCF Record          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_OBJ_OLD              Supplies All Entries for 'Old' Object-Related Cash Flow     .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_OBJ_X                Supplies All Entries for OCF Including Additional Data      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_OBJ_X_OLD            Supplies All Entries for 'Old' OCF Including Additional Data.
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_PAY                  Supplies All Entries for Payment-Related Cash Flow          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_PAY_BY_OBJGUID       Supplies All Entries for OCF that Belong to PCF Record      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_PAY_OLD              Supplies All Entries for 'Old' Payment-Related Cash Flow    .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_PAY_X                Supplies All Entries for PCF Including Additional Data      .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_LIST_PAY_X_OLD            Supplies All Entries for 'Old' PCF Including Additional Data.
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I GET_PAYING_CONTEXT            Gets Payment Context for Item                               .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I HANDLE_CFPOSTINGFROM_CHANGED  Handles Changes from CFPOSTINGFROM                          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I INSERT_OBJ                    Adds an Entry to OCF                                        .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I INSERT_PAY                    Adds an Entry to PCF                                        .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I IS_PAYED                      Was Item Cleared?                                           .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I IS_PLAN_ACTUAL_SET            Was Actual/Plan Indicator Changed?                          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I IS_RELEVANT_FOR_CASHFLOW      Asks If the Condition Is Required for Generation            .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I MODIFY_DUEDATE_OBJ            Modifies Due Date of OCF Record                             .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I MODIFY_DUEDATE_PAY            Modifies Due Date of PCF Record                             .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_COMPARE_MODE              Sets Comparison Mode =" IS_MODIFIED Displays Popup          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_DELETION_IND              Sets Deletion Indicator for Allowed Actual Records          .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_FORCE_STORE               Forces Saving (for Example, for Generating Cash Management) .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_LIST_OBJ                  Sets All Entries in Object-Related Cash Flow                .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_LIST_PAY                  Sets All Entries in Payment-Related Cash Flow               .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_PLAN_ACTUAL_OBJ           Sets Plan/Actual Indicator in OCF                           .
IF_RECD_CASHFLOW_MNGR          I SET_PLAN_ACTUAL_PAY           Sets Plan/Actual Indicator in PCF                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CALC_TAX_AND_ROUND            Calculates Tax Amount and Rounds                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CAN_DIST_EXISTS               Can Distribution Values Exist?                              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_ADJM_CONTEXT            Checks If Adjustment Field Is Correct                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_ADVANCE_PAYMENT         Checks If Data of AP Condition Is OK                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_ALL                     Checks If All Condition Data Is Consistent                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CALCRULE                Checks If the Calculation Formula Is Consistent             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CALCRULEPARA            Checks If  Parameter of Calculation Formula Is Consistent   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CHGREASON               Checks If the Reason for Change Is Consistent               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CONDCURR                Checks If the Condition Currency Is Consistent              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CONDPURPOSEEXT          Checks If the External Purpose Is Consistent                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CONDTYPE                Checks If the Condition Type Is Consistent                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CONDVALIDFROM           Checks If the Condition Start Is Consistent                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_CONDVALIDTO             Checks If the Condition End Is Consistent                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_DISTRULE                Checks If the Distribution Formula Is Consistent            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_DISTRULEPARA            Checks If Parameter of Distribution Formula Is Consistent   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_DIST_COMPLETENESS       Checks the Completeness of the Distribution                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_DIST_OBJECTS            Checks the Distribution Objects                             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_DUEDATEUP               Checks Due Dates for Follow-Up Postings                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_EXDUEDATE               Checks the Example Due Date                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_OBJECTS                 Checks If the Object Assignment Is Consistent               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_RHYTHM                  Checks the Dates of the Assigned Frequency Rule             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_SCS_RELATED             Checks if Data of an SC-Relevant Condition Is OK            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_TAX_CONTEXT             Checks If the Tax Parameter Is Consistent                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_TERMS                   Checks If the Condition Terms Are Consistent                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_UNITPRICE               Checks If the Unit Price Is Consistent                      .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I CHECK_WITHHOLDING_TAX         Checks the Withholding Tax Context                          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DELETE_KEY                    Deletes the Key Fields (for example, after Copying)         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DO_CALCULATION                Performs Calculation of Condition Amount                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DO_DISTRIBUTION               Performs Distribution Calculation                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DO_PREASSIGNMENT              Provides Starting Data to Condition                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DO_PREASSIGNMENT_ADJMRULE     Defaults an Adjustment Rule in the Condition                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I DO_UPDATE                     Updates Calculation and Distribution                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I EXISTS_CALCULATION            Asks If Calculation Values Exist                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_ABS_PERIOD                Supplies the Absolute Validity of a Condition Item          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_BOOKING_TERM              Supplies the Data of the Posting Term                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CALC_OBJECTS              Gets Calculation Objects                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CALC_RULE                 Supplies the Calculation Formula                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CALC_VALUES               Supplies the Calculation Amounts                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_COMPANYCODE               Gets the Company Code                                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDCURR                  Supplies Condition Currency                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDDELETE                Supplies the Deletion Indicator                             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDGUID                  Supplies the GUID                                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDPURPOSEEXT            Supplies the External Purpose                               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDPURPOSEINT            Supplies the Internal Purpose                               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDTYPE                  Supplies the Condition Type                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDVALIDFROM             Supplies the Condition Start                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CONDVALIDTO               Supplies the Condition End                                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Condition Currency                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies the Data of the Condition                          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies the Detail Data of the Condition                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_DIST_OBJECTS              Gets Distribution Objects                                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_DIST_RULE                 Supplies the Distribution Formula                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_DIST_VALUES               Supplies the Distribution Amounts                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_LOCK_CONTEXT              Gets Lock Context                                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_MARK                      Supplies Selection Indicator                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_NEXTADJMDATE              Gets Date of Next Possible Adjustment                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_NUMBER                    Supplies the Number of the Condition                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_PARTNER_CONTEXT           Supplies the Context for the Partner Data                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_PREASSIGN_CONDVALIDFROM   Supplies the Default for the Valid-From of a Condition      .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_RHYTHM_CONTEXT            Supplies the Context for the Frequency Data                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_RHYTHM_SLICES             Supplies the Time Slices for the Frequency Term             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_RHYTHM_TERM               Supplies the Data of the Frequency Term                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_STANDARD_VALUES           Gets Normed Condition Amounts on Key Date                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_TAX_CONTEXT               Supplies the Context for the Tax Calculation                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_TERMTYPES_ALLOWED         Supplies the Permitted Condition Term Categories            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_UNITPRICE                 Supplies the Unit Price                                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I GET_UNITPRICEUNIT             Supplies the Unit of the Unit Price                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I HAS_CASHFLOW                  Supplies Flag, Can Cash Flow Exist?                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Single Conditions                               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_ADJUSTABLE_BY_PROCESS      Adjustable by Adjustment Process?                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_ADVANCE_PAYMENT            Asks If the Condition Is an Advance Payment Condition       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_BOOKED                     Asks If the Condition Was Already Posted                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_DEFAULT_CONDITION          Gets the Default Condition Indicator?                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_DIST_FROM_CALC             Supplies Flag, Was Distribution Specified by Calculation?   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_DUEDATEUP_NECESSARY        Gets Flag If Follow-Up Posting Date Is Necessary?           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_FLATRATE                   Asks If Condition Is a Flat Rate                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_MODIFIED                   Has Status of Instance Changed?                             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_OK                         Checks If there Are Errors or Warnings?                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_PREVIOUS_CONDITION         Gets Transferred Condition Indicator? - Previous Object     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_SCS_RELATED                Asks If the Condition Is Relevant to SCS                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_TAKEOVER_CONDITION         Gets Transferred Condition Indicator? - Object              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_TAX_CONDITION              Gets Flag, Is the Condition Relevant for Taxes?             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_TAX_CONTEXT_CONSTANT       Asks If Tax Context Remains Constant                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_TERMTYPE_ALLOWED           Is the Term Category for the Condition Permitted?           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I IS_UNIQUE_COND                Asks If It Is a One-Time Condition                          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I MARK_AS_DEFAULT_CONDITION     Sets Default Condition Indicator                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I MARK_AS_PREVIOUS_CONDITION    Sets the Transferred Condition Indicator - Previous Object  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I MARK_AS_TAKEOVER_CONDITION    Sets the Transferred Condition Indicator - Object           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I RELEASE                       Release data                                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I ROUND_UNITPRICE               Rounds the Unit Price                                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_ACTIVITY                  Changes the Activity                                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_BOOKED_FLAG_DONE          Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_BOOKED_OBJ_FLAG           Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_BOOKED_PAY_FLAG           Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_CALC_VALUES               Changes the Calculation Amounts                             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_COMPARENRCALC             Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_COMPARENRDIST             Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_CONDDELETE                Sets Deletion Indicator                                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_CONDPURPOSEEXT            Changes the External Purpose                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_CURRENCY                  Changes the Condition Currency                              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_DETAIL                    Changes the Data of the Condition                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_DIST_VALUES               Changes the Distribution Amounts                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_EXDUEDATE                 Changes the Example Due Date                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_FULL_HANDLED              Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_MARK                      Changes Selection Indicator                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_NEXTADJMDATE              Sets Date of Next Possible Adjustment                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_NUMBER                    Changes the Number of the Condition                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_RAISE_EVENT_ALLOWED       Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_UNITPRICE                 Sets the Unit Price                                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_VALIDFROM_ORIGINAL        Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION              I SET_VALIDFROM_TAKEOVER        Sets Instance Attributes                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I APPEND_LIST                   Adds the Transferred Conditions                             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CAN_DIST_EXISTS               Do Conditions Exist with Possible Distributions             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CHANGE_CONDITION              Changes a Condition                                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CHANGE_OBJECT                 Changes the Object in the Conditions                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks the Authorizations for Conditions                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CHECK_VALID_RULE_RESULT       Checks Validity of Calculation and Distribution             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I COMPLETE_DETAIL               Adds Certain Data to a Condition                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I COMPLETE_OBJECT_DETAIL        Adds Certain Data to the Object Data of a Condition         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I CONVERT_UNITPRICE             Converts the Unit Price from Various Formulas               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I COPY_CONDITION                Copies a Condition                                          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I COUNT_CONDITION               Counts the Conditions and Returns the Number                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DELETE_CONDITION              Deletes a Condition                                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DO_PREASSIGNMENT_ADJMRULE     Defaults the Adjustment Rule per Customizing                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DO_UPDATE                     Updates Calculation and Distribution of All Conditions      .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DO_UPDATE_DEPEND              Updates Calculation and Distribution of Dependent Conditions.
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DO_VALID_CORRECTION           Performs Start/End Adjustments                              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I DUPLICATE_CONDITION           Adjustment: Adds Condition with Template (Same)             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I EDIT_BY_DIALOG                Process Conditions in Dialot                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I EXISTS_TEXT                   Asks If a Text Exists                                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_ADJM_MNGR_OF_PARENT       Gets Adjustment Manager of Condition User                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_COMPLETE_DISTRIBUTION     Asks If Condition Distributes Completely                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_CONDITION                 Supplies a Condition                                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_CONDTYPE_LIST             Supplies List of Possible Condition Types                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Condition Currency                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_DATE_FOR_NEW_TERM_ENTRY   Supplies Valid-From Date for a Term Entry                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_DEFAULT_CONDITIONS        Supplies Default Condition for an Object                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_FILTER                    Supplies the Current Filter Values                          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Supplies List of the Condition Objects                      .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_LIST_BY_OBJNR             Supplies List of the Condition Objects for an Object        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Supplies List of the Condition Objects for an Object        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_MARK                      Is Selection Indicator of a Condition Set?                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_NEW_GUID                  Supplies a New GUID                                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_OBJECTS_OF_CONDITION      Gets the Objects for the Condtion                           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_OBJECT_MNGR               Supplies the Object Manager                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_PARENT_DATA               Supplies Data of Condition Owner                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_PARTNER_MNGR_OF_PARENT    Supplies Partner Manager of Condition User                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_POINTER_OF_CONDITION      Gets the Reference to the Condition                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_PROPOSAL_CONDITIONS       Supplies the Default Conditions for an Object               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_TAKEOVER_CONDITIONS       Supplies Transferred Conditions for an Object               .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_TERMTYPES_ALLOWED         Gets Condition Term Categories                              .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_TERM_MNGR_OF_PARENT       Supplies the Term Manager of the Condition User             .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I GET_UPDATE_REGISTRATION       Gets Indicator If Registration Existed                      .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I HAS_COND_WITH_DIST            Asks If a Condition with Distribution Exists                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I HAS_DEFAULT_CONDITIONS        Asks If Default Conditions Exist                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I HAS_OBJECT_ASSIGN             Asks If There Is an Object Assignment                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I HAS_PROPOSAL_CONDITIONS       Asks If Default Conditions Exist                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I HAS_TAKEOVER_CONDITIONS       Asks If Transferred Conditions Exist                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes the Conditions                                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I INSERT_CONDITION              Adds a Condition                                            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I INSERT_PROPOSAL_CONDITIONS    Adds Default Conditions                                     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_ADJUSTED_BY_PROCESS        Asks If Process Adjustment Indicator Is Set                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_BOOKED                     Asks If the Condition(s) Was (Were) Posted                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_CONDPURPOSE_ENABLED        Is Entering the Condition Purpose Allowed?                  .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_DUEDATEUP_NECESSARY        Gets Flag If Follow-Up Posting Date Is Necessary?           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_OBJECT_RELATING_ALLOWED    Is the Object Assignment to the Conditions Allowed?         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_RELEVANT_FOR_REGISTRATION  Asks If Conditions Are Relevant for Registration            .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I IS_UPDATE_DISABLED            Asks If the Update Indicator Is Set                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I MARK_FOR_CASHFLOW_UPDATE      IS_MODIFIED Supplies TRUE and Cash Flow Is Generated        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I MARK_RELEASED_SWITCHED_TO_OFF Selection Change (Active(Free)-"Not Active(Free))           .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I NEW_CONDITION                 Adjustment: Adds Condition with Template (External)         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I NUMBER_CONDITION              Renumbers the Conditions                                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I RAISE_AFTER_CHANGE            Creates Raise for Condition                                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I RESET_FILTER                  Deletes Filter Values                                       .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I REVERSE_CONDITION             Adjustment: Deletes a Condition Inserted with DUPLICATE     .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_ADJUSTED_BY_PROCESS       Changes the Process Adjustment Indicator                    .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_COMPARE_MODE              Sets Comparison Mode =" IS_MODIFIED Displays Popup          .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_COMPARE_NUMBER            Sets Comparison Indicator in the Conditions                 .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_FILTER                    Changes the Filter Values                                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Sets the List of Conditions Objects                         .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_TEXT                      Sets the Text of the Memo                                   .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SET_UPDATE_DISABLED           Changes the Update Indicator                                .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I SORT_CONDITION                Sorts the Conditions                                        .
IF_RECD_CONDITION_MNGR         I UNDO_DELETED_CONDITION        Gets Deleted Conditions Back                                .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I CHECK_PARAMETER               Checks If Transferred Parameter Allowed                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I EXISTS_PARAMETER              Checks If Parameters Exist                                  .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_COMPLETE_DISTRIBUTION     Gets Full Distribution                                      .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_CUSTOMIZING_MOD           Supplies Modification Indic.-Customizing for the Parameter  .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_DEFAULT_PARAMETER         Supplies Default Parameter in Dependency...                 .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_GUI_PARAMETER_FUNCTION    Gets Modules for Parameter Maintenance                      .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_INFO_ID                   Gets ID for Information                                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_OBJECT_INFO               Gets Info for Distribution Object                           .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_DESCRIPTION     Supplies Parameter Description                              .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_INFO            Supplies Descriptive Text for a Parameter                   .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_PARAMETER_LIST            Supplies a List of All Possible Parameters                  .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I GET_VALUES                    Supplies the Distribution Amounts                           .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_BADI_RULE                  Ask If It Is a BAdI Formula?                                .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_CHECK_COMPLETENESS         Is Full Check Active?                                       .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_DIRECT_DISTRIBUTION        Is Direct Distribution Active?                              .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_INTERN                     Is It an Internal Formula?                                  .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_MODIFIABLE                 Can the Data Be Modified?                                   .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I IS_OBJECT_NECESSARY           Is the distribution object needed?                          .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I NEED_OBJECT_DATA              Is Object Data Needed for Calculation?                      .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I SET_INTERN                    Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I SET_MODIFY                    Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I SET_PARAMETER1                Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I SET_PARAMETER2                Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_DIST_RULE              I SET_RULE                      Sets Instance Attribute                                     .
IF_RECD_HAS_CASHFLOW           I GET_CASHFLOW_MNGR             Supplies Cash Flow Manager                                  .
IF_RECD_HAS_CASHFLOW           I IS_CASHFLOW_STORE_ENABLED     Asks If Cash Flow Can Be Saved                              .
IF_RECD_HAS_CONDITION          I GET_CONDGROUP                 Supplies Condition Group                                    .
IF_RECD_HAS_CONDITION          I GET_CONDITION_MNGR            Supplies the Conditions Manager                             .
IF_RECD_HAS_CONDITION          I GET_CONDITION_MNGR_TYPE       Supplies Object Type of the Condition Owner                 .
IF_RECD_HAS_DEFAULT_CONDITION  I GET_DEF_COND_GROUP_VAL        Supplies Condition Group and Valuation Type for Default Cnd .
IF_RECIPIENT_BCS               I RESOLVE                       Gets Address Structure for Send Module                      .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG2_BCS       I CHECK_RECIPIENT_NAME_DIRECT   Recipient is to be determined after direct entry            .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG2_BCS       I CHECK_RECIPIENT_NAME_IN_F4    Recipient is to be determined by F4 Help                    .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG2_BCS       I COMM_ADDRESS_IS_SWITCHABLE    Communication address can be changed                        .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG2_BCS       I SWITCH_COMM_ADDRESS           Change Communication Address                                .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I CHECK_RECIPIENT_AUTHORITY     Checks Send Authorization for This Instance                 .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I CHECK_RECIPIENT_NAME          "" Obsolete ""                                              .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I CHECK_SEND_AUTHORITY          Checks Whether This Type Can Be Used                        .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I COMPARE                       Compares Recipient with Another Instance (Semantic)         .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I DISPLAY                       Displays Recipient                                          .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I EDIT                          Allows Recipient to Be Modified Using Dialog                .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_ADDRESS_DATA              Gets Addr. Data for Recipient (for Example, for Cover Sheet).
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_DEFAULT_ATTRIBUTES        Default Recipient Attributes for This Recipient             .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_GROUP_NAME                Returns Grouping ID (Like Distribution Lists)               .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_GROUP_TYPE                Gets Abbreviation for Grouping Recipients of This Type      .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_OID_BY_REF                Returns UID of Object Services                              .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_RECIPIENT_NAME            Gets Descriptive Name of Recipient                          .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_RECIPIENT_SORTFIELD       Fills Sort Field for This Recipient                         .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_RECIPIENT_TYPE_NAME       Gets Descriptive Name of Recipient Type                     .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_RECIPIENT_TYPE_NAME_DETAILGets Detailed Recipient Type Name for an Instance           .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_REF_BY_OID                Returns Reference from UID of Object Services               .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I GET_SORT_GROUP                Gets Sort Class 1 = Up, 2 = Down                            .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I IS_PERSONALIZABLE             Recipient Is Unit for Personalized Mail                     .
IF_RECIPIENT_DIALOG_BCS        I NEW                           Dialog for Determining a New Recipient                      .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Actual Security Deposit                             .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_TOTAL_ON_DATERANGE        Gets the Totaled Actual Security Deposits for a Period      .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I GET_TOTAL_ON_KEYDATE          Gets the Totaled Actual Security Deposits for a Key Date    .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I INSERT_DETAIL                 Creates a New Actual Security Deposit                       .
IF_RECN_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR    I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Actual Security Deposit                             .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_DEPOSIT                 Performs Checks for Security Deposit Agreements             .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_DPTARGETTYPE            Checks the Security Deposit Type                            .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_INDUSTRY                Checks the Industry                                         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECN2DAT                Checks Date of 2nd Signature                                .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNBUKRSCOLLECT        Checks Company Code of Main Contract                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNCNCURR              Checks Contract Currency                                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNDAT                 Checks Date of Contract Conclusion                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNNR                  Checks Contract Number                                      .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNNRCOLLECT           Checks Number of Main Contract                              .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNTLAW                Checks Tenancy Law                                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNTXT                 Checks Contract Name                                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNTXTOLD              Checks Contract Number of Old Contract                      .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_RECNTYPE                Checks External Contract Type                               .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_SRRELEVANT              Checks "Relevant to Sales" Indicator in Contract            .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I CHECK_TRANSFER_POSSESSION     Checks Transfer of Possession                               .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I DO_ACTIVATE                   Activates Contract                                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I DO_DEACTIVATE                 Deactivates Contract                                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I DO_STATUS_TRANSACTION         Executes Transferred Activity                               .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_ACTUAL_DEPOSIT_MNGR       Gets the Actual Security Deposit Manager                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_CASHFLOW_MNGR             Supplies Cash Flow Manager                                  .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_CFPOSTINGFROM             Supplies Date of First Posting                              .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_COST_CENTER               Delivers Cost Center                                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_IMKEY                     Delivers Internal Key for Real Estate Object                .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_MEASCN_MNGR               Gets Contract Measurement Manager                           .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_NOTICE_MNGR               Supplies Notice Manager (Process)                           .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNBEG                   Supplies Contract Start Date                                .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNCNCURR                Supplies Contract Currency                                  .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNCURR                  Supplies Local Currency                                     .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNDPO                   Supplies Date of Cash Flow Generated Starting On            .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNEND1ST                Supplies First Contract End Date                            .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RECNENDABS                Supplies End Date (Including Notice/Renewal)                .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_RENEWAL_MNGR              Supplies Renewal Manager (Process)                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_SCCNPART_MNGR             Supplies Settlement Participation Generator                 .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_SRRELEVANT                Supplies Relevance to Sales-Based Rent                      .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_ADJUSTMENT_MNGR      Supplies Adjustment Term Manager (Terms)                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_NOTICE_MNGR          Supplies Notice Manager (Terms)                             .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_NOTICE_OBJ_MNGR      Supplies Notice Manager for Objects (Terms)                 .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_PAYMENT_MNGR         Supplies Payment Rule Manager (Terms)                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_PERIOD_MNGR          Supplies Term Manager (Terms)                               .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_RENEWAL_MNGR         Supplies the Renewal Manager (Terms)                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_RENEWAL_OBJ_MNGR     Gets Renewal Manager for Objects (Terms)                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_RHYTHM_MNGR          Supplies Frequency Term Manager (Terms)                     .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TERM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR Gets the Withholding Tax Manager (Terms)                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_TRANSFER_POSSESSION       Gets the Period for the Transfer of Possession              .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I GET_USERSUPPLIER              Supplies Contractor and Contractee                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I INIT_BY_TEMPLATE              Initializes Instance via Field String of Basic Data         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_ACCOUNT                    Asks If It Is a G/L Account Contract                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_ACTIVE                     Is Contract Active                                          .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_ASSESSMENT                 Asks If Contract Is an Assessment Contract                  .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_CONDOMINIUM_OWNERS         Asks If Contract Is Condominium Management Contract         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_DEBIT                      Asks If Contract Is Customer Contract                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_DEPOSIT                    Asks If Contract Is Security Deposit Agreement              .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_DIRECTION_SUPPLIER         Asks If Contract Is an Offering Contract                    .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_DIRECTION_USER             Asks If Contract Is a Using Contract                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_INTERN                     Asks If Internal Contract Is Involved                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_MANAGEMENT                 Asks If Contract Is a Management Contract                   .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_OCCUPYING                  Asks If Contract Is an Occupancy Contract                   .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_SR_RELEVANT                Relevant for Sales-Based Rent?                              .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I IS_TAXFREE                    Asks If Contract Is Non-Tax Contract                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_BENOCN                    Changes Main BE of Contract, Possibly Automatic from Object .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_DPTARGETTYPE              Changes the Security Deposit Type                           .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_INDUSTRY                  Changes the Industry                                        .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECN2DAT                  Changes Date of 2nd Signature                               .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNBUKRSCOLLECT          Changes Company Code of Main Contract                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNCNCURR                Changes Contract Currency                                   .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNDAT                   Changes Date of Contract Conclusion                         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNNR                    Changes RE Contract Number                                  .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNNRCOLLECT             Changes Number of Main Real Estate Contract                 .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNTLAW                  Changes Tenancy Law                                         .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNTXT                   Changes Contract Name                                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNTXTOLD                Changes Contract Number of Old Contract                     .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_RECNTYPE                  Changes Real Estate External Contract Type                  .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_SRRELEVANT                Changes Relevance to Sales-Based Rent                       .
IF_RECN_CONTRACT               I SET_TRANSFER_POSSESSION       Sets the Period for the Transfer of Possession              .
IF_RECN_HAS_MEASCN             I GET_MEASCN_MNGR               Gets Contract Measurement Manager                           .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Single Date                                          .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I COMPRESS_TABLE                Summarization of Measurements Table                         .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I GET_MEAS_FOR_CREATE           Gets Measurements Thar Are Defaulted                        .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I GET_MEAS_FOR_INSERT           Gets Measurements That Can Be Added                         .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Entry                                                  .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_RECN_MEASCN_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Individual Contract Measurement                     .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I ACTIVATE                      Activates Notice                                            .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I CHECK_PROCESS_ALLOWED         Is the Notice Allowed?                                      .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I DEACTIVATE                    Cancels Notice                                              .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Notice                                              .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I DELETE_OBJREL                 Deletes Object Assignment                                   .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I EXISTS_ANY_NOTICE             Checks If There Is at Least One Notice                      .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I EXISTS_ANY_OBJREL             Is at Least One Object Assigned?                            .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_ALLOWED_NOTICE_CATEGORY   Supplies Reliable Notice Types (Contract/Objects)           .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_ALL_OBJ_FOR_ACTIVE_NOTICE Gets All Objects on Which Notice Was Given                  .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR          Supplies Notice Procedure Manager                           .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_OBJREL_LIST               Gets List of Assigned Objects                               .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I HAS_OBJREL_DISTINCT_TERM      Do the Objects Belong to Different Notice Terms?            .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I INSERT_DETAIL                 Creates New Notice                                          .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I INSERT_OBJREL                 Adds Object Assignment                                      .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I IS_ACTIVATE_ALLOWED           Is activation of a particular notice allowed?               .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I IS_DEACTIVATE_ALLOWED         Is deactivation of particular notice allowed?               .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I IS_DELETE_ALLOWED             Is deletion of a particular notice allowed?                 .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I IS_INSERT_ALLOWED             Is creation of a new notice allowed?                        .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I IS_OBJREL_ALLOWED             Is Object Assignment for Notice Allowed?                    .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I SET_OBJREL_LIST               Changes the List of Assigned Objects                        .
IF_RECN_NOTICE_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Notice                                              .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I ACCEPT                        Activates Approval of Renewal                               .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I ACTIVATE                      Activates Renewal                                           .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I CHECK_PROCESS_ALLOWED         Is the Renewal Allowed?                                     .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I DEACTIVATE                    Cancels Renewal                                             .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I EXISTS_ANY_RENEWAL            Checks if there is at least one renewal                     .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_ABS_END_DATE              Supplies End of Term in Relation to Renewal                 .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_MAX_END_DATE              Gets the Maximim Contract End (Approve All Open Options)    .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_NEW_END_DATE              Supplies Next Contract End                                  .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR         Supplies Renewal Manager                                    .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I IS_ACCEPT_ALLOWED             Is Approval+Activation of a Certain Renewal Allowed?        .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I IS_ACTIVATE_ALLOWED           Is Activating a Certain Renewal Allowed?                    .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I IS_DEACTIVATE_ALLOWED         Is Deactivating a Certain Renewal Allowed?                  .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I IS_REJECT_ALLOWED             Is Rejection+Activation of a Certain Renewal Allowed?       .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I REJECT                        Activates Rejection of Renewal                              .
IF_RECN_RENEWAL_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Renewal                                             .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETEXCLUDINGFCODES            Get the Excluding F Codes for the GUI Recon. Detail Status  .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETGUITITLE                   Get the GUI Title of the Recon. Detail Status Screen        .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETNUMBERID                   Get the Number ID of the Reconciliation Entity              .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETNUMBERIDINTERNAL           Get the Number ID in Internal Format                        .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETNUMBEROFPOSITIONS          Get the number of positions for a security ID, 0 or 1 is ret.
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETPOSITIONS                  Get the Position Data (in SAP List Viewer Format)           .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETRECONDATA                  Get the Data of the Reconciliation Entity                   .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I GETSCREENSTATUSFORFIELD       Get the Screen Status of a Field on a Screen                .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I PUTRECONDATA                  Remove the Reconciliation Entity Data from the screen       .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I REFRESHPOSITIONS              Refresh the Positions of Reconciliation Entity              .
IF_RECON_ENTITY_TRS            I SETTEXTEDITORANDUPDATE        Set the Text Editor for the Reconciliation Entity           .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETPOSEXCLUDINGFCODES         Get the Excluding F Codes for the GUI Position Detail Status.
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETPOSGUITITLE                Get the GUI Title of the Position Detail Status Screen      .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETPOSITIONDATA               Get the Position Data                                       .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETPOSNUMBERID                Get the Number ID of the Reconciliation Entity              .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETPOSSCREENSTATUSFORFIELD    Get the Screen Status of a Field on a Screen                .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I GETSECURITYID                 Get the Security ID of the Position                         .
IF_RECON_POSITION_TRS          I SETPOSITIONDATA               Set the Position Data                                       .
IF_RECOVERABLE_RL              I BACKUP                        Create Recovery Information (only ApplStatus)               .
IF_RECOVERABLE_RL              I COMMIT                        Adopt New Status                                            .
IF_RECOVERABLE_RL              I RESTORE                       Reset to Previous Status (only ApplStatus)                  .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I DELETE                        Deletes an Allocation Rule                                  .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I EXISTS_RULE                   Does Settlement Rule Exist?                                 .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I GET_DEFAULT_PROFILE           Gets Default Profile Entered in Customizing                 .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Gets List of Current Allocation Rules                       .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I GET_OBJNR                     Gets Object Number (Real or Temporary)                      .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via the Superordinate Object [final]     .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I RULE_IS_USED                  Checks If an Allocation Rule Was Already Used               .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I SET_LIST                      Sets Allocation Rules                                       .
IF_RECO_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR     I SET_PROFILE                   Sets Settlement Profile                                     .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I CHECK_ITEM                    Checks Data Record                                          .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I DEQUEUE                       Removes Lock                                                .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I DISTRIBUTE_TOTALS             Distributes Totals Record to Periods                        .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I ENQUEUE                       Sets Lock                                                   .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_COSTELEMENT_LIST          Gets List of Selected Cost Elements                         .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_CURRENCY                  Gets Currency                                               .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_ITEM                      Gets Period Value                                           .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_LIST                      Gets List of All Records                                    .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_LIST_FOR_TOTAL            Gets Period Records for Totals Record                       .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_LIST_X                    Gets List of All Records Incl. Additional Data              .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Gets List of Objects to Be Planned                          .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_OBJECT_LIST_X             Gets List of Objects to Be Planned with Additional Fields   .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_PARAM                     Gets Selection Parameters                                   .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_PERIOD_LIST               Gets List of Selected Periods                               .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_TOTALS_LIST               Gets List of Totals Values                                  .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I GET_TOTALS_LIST_X             Gets List of Totals Values and Additional Fields            .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I INIT                          Initializes (Empty Object)                                  .
IF_RECO_DATA                   I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initialization with Reading of Initial Data                 .
IF_RECO_HAS_COSETTLE_RULE      I GET_COSETTLE_RULE_MNGR        Gets Manager for CO Settlement                              .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I CHECK_ITEM                    Checks Data Record                                          .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I DEQUEUE                       Removes Locks                                               .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I DISTRIBUTE_TOTALS             Distributes Totals Record to Periods                        .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I ENQUEUE                       Sets Locks                                                  .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_COSTELEMENT_LIST          Gets List of Selected Cost Elements                         .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_LIST                      Gets List of All Planned Records                            .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_LIST_FOR_TOTAL            Gets Period Records for Totals Record                       .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_OBJECT_LIST               Gets List of Objects to Be Planned                          .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_OBJECT_LIST_X             Gets List of Objects to Be Planned with Additional Fields   .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_PARAM                     Gets Selection Parameters                                   .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_TOTALS_LIST               Gets List of Totals Values                                  .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I GET_TOTALS_LIST_X             Gets List of Totals Values and Additional Fields            .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I INIT                          Initializes (Empty Object)                                  .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initialization with Reading of Initial Data                 .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I MODIFY_ITEM                   Changes Planned Data Record                                 .
IF_RECO_PLANDATA               I SET_LIST                      Sets Planned Data Records                                   .
IF_RECP_FP_INTF                I PROCESS_FORM                  Calls the PDF-Based Form [Final]                            .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I CHECK_ALL                     Checks CorrApplication For Consistency of Settings          .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I GET_DOC_LIST                  Delivers Reference to Document List                         .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I INIT                          Initializes Instance                                        .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I PRINT_DOC                     Starts Office Application                                   .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I SET_APPLOUTPLACE              Changes Indicator for Whether Separate Window Is Used       .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I SET_PRNDATE                   Changes Print Date                                          .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I SET_SELDATE                   Changes Key Date for Data Retrieval                         .
IF_RECP_OI_APP                 I SET_TEMPLATE                  Changes Office Template                                     .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I BUILD_AND_PRINT_DOC_LIST      Prints Documents for a List of Business Objects [Final]     .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I BUILD_DOC_LIST                Creates Document List for a List of Business Objects [Final].
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I CHECK_ALL                     Checks CorrApplication For Consistency of Settings [Final]  .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I CHECK_BUSOBJ_ALLOWED          Checks if Bus.Object is Printed with This CorrApplic.[Final].
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I FREE                          Releases Resources of Instance [Final]                      .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_ARCH_DEFAULT              Delivers Default Archiving Parameters [Final]               .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_BADI_DATA                 Delivers Values of BAdI User Fields [Final]                 .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_CORR_ACT_BY_BUSOBJ        Delivers CorrActivity for Bus.Object(via DiffCharach)[Final].
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_CORR_ACT_DEFAULT          Delivers Default CorrActivity for CorrApplication [Final]   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_CORR_ACT_LIST             Delivers All Active CorrActivities of CorrApplication[Final].
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_CUKY2ND_DEFAULT           Delivers Default Value for 2nd Currency [Final]             .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_DOCLIST_DEFAULT           Delivers Default Settings for Document List [Final]         .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_DOC_LIST                  Delivers Reference to Document List [Final]                 .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_DOC_LIST_INFO             Delivers Information for Document List [Final]              .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_FAX_DEFAULT               Delivers Default Settings for Fax [Final]                   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_MAIL_DEFAULT              Delivers Default Settings for E-Mail [Final]                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_PRINT_DEFAULT             Delivers Default Print Parameters [Final]                   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_SORTVER_DEFAULT           Delivers Default Sort Variant [Final]                       .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_SORTVER_LIST              Delivers All Sort Variants [Final]                          .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_SPEC_OPTIONS              Supplies Specific Paramaters of Correspondence Application  .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_TEXT_REF                  Delivers Reference from Text of Text Editor [Final]         .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_TM_DEFAULT                Delivers Default Text Module [Final]                        .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I GET_TM_LIST                   Delivers All Includable Text Modules [Final]                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I HAS_DOC                       Document List Contains At Least 1 Doc(Cond.for Print)[Final].
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I INIT                          Initializes Instance [Final]                                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_ARCH_SUPPORTED             Is Archiving Supported? [Final]                             .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_CORR_ACT_CHANGEABLE        Can CorrActivity Be Changed Manually? [Final]               .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_CUKY2ND_CHANGEABLE         Can 2nd Currency Be Changed Manually? [Final]               .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_FAX_SUPPORTED              Is Fax Supported? [Final]                                   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_MAIL_SUPPORTED             Is E-Mail Supported? [Final]                                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_SORTVER_CHANGEABLE         Can Sort Variant Be Changed Manually? [Final]               .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_TEXTEDIT_USED              Is Text Editor Used? [Final]                                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I IS_TM_SELECTION_USED          Is Text Module Selection Used? [Final]                      .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I PREVIEW_DOC                   Displays Doc.From Prev. Doc.List in Print Prev. [Final]     .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I PRINT_DOC_LIST                Print Documents From Original Document List [Final]         .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_ARCH_OPTIONS              Changes Archiving Parameters [Final]                        .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_BADI_DATA                 Changes Values of BAdi User Fields [Final]                  .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_CORR_ACT_FORCE            Overrides Correspondence Activity [Final]                   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_CUKY2ND_OPTIONS           Changes Settings for Translation in 2nd Curr. [Final]       .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_DOCLIST_OPTIONS           Changes Settings in Document List [Final]                   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_FAX_OPTIONS               Changes Settings per Fax [Final]                            .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_MAIL_OPTIONS              Changes Settings per E-Mail [Final]                         .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_PRINT_OPTIONS             Changes Print Parameters [Final]                            .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_PRNDATE                   Changes Print Date [Final]                                  .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_SELDATE                   Changes Key Date for Data Retrieval [Final]                 .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_SORTVER                   Changes Sort Variant [Final]                                .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_SPEC_OPTIONS              Changes Specific Paramaters of Correspondence Application   .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I SET_TM_INCLUDE                Changes Text Modulde to Be Included [Final]                 .
IF_RECP_SF_APP                 I STORE_TEXT                    Saves Text for Print Activity [Final]                       .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I CLOSE                         Closes Current Output Activity                              .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I FREE                          Frees Resources                                             .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I INIT                          Initializes Print Order                                     .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I OPEN                          Opens New Output Activity                                   .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I PREVIEW                       Displays Print Preview (w/o OPEN/CLOSe)                     .
IF_RECP_SF_JOB                 I PRINT                         Prints Document (OPEN/CLOSE required)                       .
IF_REEX_ACCRUAL_OBJECT         I DELETE                        Deletes Accrual Object                                      .
IF_REEX_ACCRUAL_OBJECT         I INIT_BY_DATA                  Initializes Accrual Object Using the Data                   .
IF_REEX_ACCRUAL_OBJECT         I INIT_FOR_REV                  Initializes Accrual Object for Reversal                     .
IF_REEX_ACCRUAL_OBJECT         I MODIFY                        Changes Accrual Object                                      .
IF_REEX_ACCRUAL_OBJECT         I REVERSE                       Reverses Accrual Object                                     .
IF_REEX_ASSET                  I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REEX_ASSET                  I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REEX_ASSET                  I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REEX_ASSET                  I GET_MAIN_USAGE_TYPE           Gets Main Usage Type                                        .
IF_REEX_ASSET                  I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_REEX_CLASSIFICATION_MNGR    I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REEX_CLASSIFICATION_MNGR    I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REEX_CLASSIFICATION_MNGR    I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REEX_CLASSIFICATION_MNGR    I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_REEX_COSTCENTER             I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REEX_COSTCENTER             I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REEX_COSTCENTER             I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REEX_COSTCENTER             I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_REEX_DART_EXTRACT           I GET_DATA                      Gets Data Packets                                           .
IF_REEX_DART_EXTRACT           I INIT                          Initializes Data Retrieval [Final]                          .
IF_REEX_DATA_POSTING_CC        I SET_SELECT                    Which Documents Should Be Selected                          .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I CHANGE_DETAIL_AM              Change Relationship to Asset                                .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I DELETE_DETAIL_AM              Remove Relationship to Asset                                .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I GET_LIST_AM                   Gets All Entries (FI-AA)                                    .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I GET_LIST_AM_X                 Gets All Entries (FI-AA) Including Additional Data          .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I GET_MAIN_ASSET                Gets the Leading Asset                                      .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I GET_NEW_ASSETS                Supplies Newly Created Assets                               .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I INSERT_DETAIL_AM              Link to Asset                                               .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_AM     I SET_NEW_ASSETS                Sets Newly Created Assets                                   .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_CC     I GET_LIST_COSTCENTER           Gets All Entries - Cost Centers                             .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_CC     I GET_LIST_COSTCENTER_X         Gets All Entries - Cost Centers Incl. Addit. Fields         .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_CC     I UPDATE_DETAIL_COSTCENTER      Changes Entry - Cost Center                                 .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_OR     I GET_DETAIL_ORDER              Gets Entry - Orders                                         .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_OR     I GET_DETAIL_ORDER_X            Gets Entry - Orders Including Additional Data               .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_OR     I GET_LIST_ORDER                Gets All Entries - Orders                                   .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_OR     I GET_LIST_ORDER_X              Gets All Entries - Orders Including Additional Data         .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_OR     I UPDATE_DETAIL_ORDER           Changes Entry - Order                                       .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PS     I GET_LIST_WBS_ELEMENT          Gets All Entries - WBS Elements                             .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PS     I GET_LIST_WBS_ELEMENT_X        Gets All Entries - WBS Elements Incl. Additional Data       .
IF_REEX_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR_PS     I UPDATE_DETAIL_WBS_ELEMENT     Changes Entry - WBS Element                                 .
IF_REEX_ORDER                  I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REEX_ORDER                  I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REEX_ORDER                  I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REEX_ORDER                  I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_REEX_ORDER                  I IS_PM_ORDER                   Checks If the Order Is a Maintenance Order                  .
IF_REEX_PREP_ACCT_SHEET_RES_FI I GET_LIST                      List of RE Documents                                        .
IF_REEX_PREP_ACCT_SHEET_RES_FI I INIT                          Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_REEX_SET                    I ADD_ITEM                      Adds an Item to the Set Definition                          .
IF_REEX_SET                    I CHECK_ALL                     Checks Set                                                  .
IF_REEX_SET                    I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_REEX_SET                    I CHECK_SETNAME                 Checks Validity of Set Name                                 .
IF_REEX_SET                    I CLEAR                         Deletes Set Definition                                      .
IF_REEX_SET                    I CONTAINS_ITEM                 Checks If Entry Already in Set Definition                   .
IF_REEX_SET                    I DELETE                        Deletes a Set                                               .
IF_REEX_SET                    I DELETE_ITEM                   Deletes an Entry in the Set Definition                      .
IF_REEX_SET                    I DEQUEUE                       Removes Lock                                                .
IF_REEX_SET                    I ENQUEUE                       Sets Lock                                                   .
IF_REEX_SET                    I EXISTS                        Checks If Set Exists                                        .
IF_REEX_SET                    I FREE                          Releases Resources and Locks                                .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_COMP_CODE_LIST            Gets List of All Company Codes of Objects in Set            .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_DEFINITION                Gets Set Definition                                         .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Detailed Information for a Set                         .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Detailed Information for a Set                         .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_HIERARCHY                 Gets Set Hierarchy                                          .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_IDENT                     Gets Set ID                                                 .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_OBJ_LIST                  Gets List of Objects in a Set                               .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_RUSER                     Gets User Data                                              .
IF_REEX_SET                    I GET_WHERE_USED_LIST           Gets Where-Used List for Set (as Subset)                    .
IF_REEX_SET                    I HAS_LINES                     Does Set Contain Objects?                                   .
IF_REEX_SET                    I INIT                          Initializes Set                                             .
IF_REEX_SET                    I IS_MODIFIED                   Data Changed?                                               .
IF_REEX_SET                    I IS_MULTI                      Is Set Multidimenstion Set?                                 .
IF_REEX_SET                    I IS_USED                       Checks If a Set Is Used                                     .
IF_REEX_SET                    I SET_DEFINITION                Sets Set Definition                                         .
IF_REEX_SET                    I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets Description of Set                                     .
IF_REEX_SET                    I SET_OBJTYPE                   Sets Object Type of Set                                     .
IF_REEX_SET                    I SET_OBJ_LIST                  Deletes Set Definition and Adds List with Objects           .
IF_REEX_SET                    I SET_SETNAME                   Sets the Set Name                                           .
IF_REEX_SET                    I STORE                         Saves the Set                                               .
IF_REEX_WBS_ELEMENT            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REEX_WBS_ELEMENT            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REEX_WBS_ELEMENT            I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REEX_WBS_ELEMENT            I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I ADAPT_SPECIAL_GROUPS          Adds Additional Field Groups for Profile                    .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I ADOPT_FIELDCATALOG            Adds Additional Columns to Field Catalog per Profile        .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I ADOPT_PROFILE_DATA_FOR_OBJECT Sets All Profile Data for a Business Object                 .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I GET_PROFILE_2                 Gets the ID of the Set Report Profile                       .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I INIT                          "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I IS_PERSISTENT                 T/F: Does Profile Exist on the Database?                    .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I SET_DATA_OBJECT               Sets the Model Components                                   .
IF_REIS_PROFILE                I SET_PROFILE_2                 Sets the Report Profile                                     .
IF_REIS_PROFILE_SPEC           I ADAPT_SPECIAL_GROUPS          Adds Additional Field Groups for Profile                    .
IF_REIS_PROFILE_SPEC           I ADOPT_FIELDCATALOG            Adds Additional Columns to Field Catalog per Profile        .
IF_REIS_PROFILE_SPEC           I ADOPT_PROFILE_DATA_FOR_OBJECT Gets Spec. Data for Bus.Obj. per Profile (Meas., Cond.,...) .
IF_REIS_PROFILE_SPEC           I INIT_BY_PARENT                "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_REIS_PROFILE_SPEC           I IS_PERSISTENT                 T/F: Does Profile Exist on the Database?                    .
IF_REIT_HAS_OPTION_RATE        I GET_OPTION_RATE_MNGR          Supplies Option Rate Manager                                .
IF_REIT_HAS_OPTION_RATE_RESULT I GET_OPTION_RATE_RESULT        Gets Result of Option Rate Determination                    .
IF_REIT_HAS_TAX_CORRECTION     I GET_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR        Gets Manager for Input Tax Correction Basis                 .
IF_REIT_HAS_TAX_CORRECTION     I GET_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR        Gets Manager for Input Tax Correction                       .
IF_REIT_HAS_TAX_CORRECTION     I GET_TAX_CORR_VARIANT          Gets Variants for Correction and Trivial Amount Limit       .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I ADJUST_ORDATE                 Adjusts Specified Key Date (Currently Month-End)            .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I CALCULATE                     Carries Out Option Rate Determination for Registered Objects.
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I CHECK_ORCALCEXTID             Checks if Ext. ID for Option Rate Determination is ok       .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Detail Data on Option Rate Determination               .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_MSGLIST_FOR_OBJ           Gets Error List for a Given Object Number                   .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_ORCALCEXTID               Supplies Ext. ID for Option Rate Determination              .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_ORDATE                    Supplies Key Date for Specified Activity                    .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_ORTEXT                    Supplies Text for Option Rate Determination                 .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_PROCESSGUID               Supplies Instance for Process ID Manager                    .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I GET_SUBOBJECTS                Supplies Infos on Obj and Subobject for Option Rate Determ. .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I INCREASE_CNTERR               Increase Counter for No. of Objects with Errors by 1        .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I INCREASE_CNTOBJ               Increase Counter for No. of Calculated Objects by 1         .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I PROPOSE_ORCALCEXTID           Defaults Ext. ID for Opt.Rate Determination Dep. on Sy-Dat  .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I PROPOSE_ORDATE                Defaults Key-Date for Opt.Rate Determination Dep. on Sy-Dat .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I PROPOSE_ORTEXT                Defaults Text for Option Rate Determination Run             .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I REGISTER_BUS_OBJ              Registr. Bus.Obj. as Obj for which OptRate to be Determined .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I SET_ORCALCEXTID               Sets Ext. ID for Option Rate Determination                  .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I SET_ORDATE                    Sets Key Date for Activity                                  .
IF_REIT_OPTIONRATE_CALCULATION I SET_ORTEXT                    Sets Text for Option Rate Determination                     .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CALCULATE_DATE_LAST_CALC_USED Sets MD_DATE_LAST_CALC and MD_DATE_LAST_USED                .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CALCULATE_OPTRATE             Calculates Option Rate on Key Date                          .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks if Option Rate is Consistent                         .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CHECK_OVERLAP                 Checks for Time Overlaps in Option Rates                    .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I CHECK_USED_IN_PERIOD          Checks If Option Rate Already Used for Distribution in Prd  .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I COPY_DETAIL                   Copies Existing Single Option Rate with Defaulted Period    .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes an Option Rate                                      .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_DATE_LAST_CALC            Supplies Date Up to Which Option Rates Were Calculated      .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X_FOR_DATE         Supplies Structure And Additional Data for a Key Date       .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_NEXT_CALC_PERIOD          Supplies Next Period for Option Rate Determination          .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_OR_MNGR_FOR_CALC          Gets Manager and Anchor Rate for Option Rate Determination  .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_RESULT_FOR_PERIOD         Supplies Result of Option Rate Determination for one Period .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_RESULT_X                  Supplies Detailed Results of Calculation                    .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_SCREEN_ATTRIBUTES         Supplies Field Attributes Dependent on OptRate Method       .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I GET_VALID_METHODS             Supplies Valid Option Rate Method Dep. on Object Category   .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New Option Rate                                     .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I INSERT_INITIAL_ANCHOR         Inserts Initial Anchor Rate with Default Values             .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I IS_INITIAL                    Checks if Option Rate Agreements Exist (Anchor/Period)      .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I IS_OPT_METH_NEEDED            Checks If Option Rate Method Needs to Exist                 .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I MANIPULATE_FOR_OUT_OF_RANGE   Prevents Error "No Anchor Rate for ORDATE", If Required     .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_MNGR       I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Single Option Rate (Insert or Update9                  .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_RESULT     I GET_RESULT_FOR_PERIOD         Gets Option Rate and Object from Which Option Rate Stems    .
IF_REIT_OPTION_RATE_RESULT     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Interface Using Superordinate Object            .
IF_REIT_OPTRATECALC_PARAM      I GET_ORPARAMS                  Supplies Option Rate Determination-Specific Basic Data      .
IF_REIT_OPTRATECALC_PARAM      I SET_ORPARAMS                  Set Option Rate Determination-Specific Basic Data           .
IF_REIT_POSTING_PARAM          I INIT_BY_TAX_DISTRIBUTION      Fill the Paramaters                                         .
IF_REIT_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_DS_LIST                   List of RE Documents for Input Tax Distribution             .
IF_REIT_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST                      List of RE Documents                                        .
IF_REIT_PREPARE_RESULTS        I INIT                          Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I ADD_CHILD                     Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I CHECK_ALL                     Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I DISTRIBUTE                    Creates Distribution Item                                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I FREE                          Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I INIT                          Initializes Document Using Primary Key                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I INIT_BY_DATA                  Initializes Document Using Data                             .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I INIT_BY_REFDOCID              Initializes Document Using External Key                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I INIT_BY_TAX_DIST_DATA         Initializes Document Using Data                             .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I IS_MODIFIED                   Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I IS_OK                         Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I POST                          Posts the Document                                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I REGISTER_ALL_CHILDREN         Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I RELEASE                       Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I REVERSE                       Reverses the Tax Breakdown Basis Item                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I SET_DIST_AMOUNTS              Sets Distribution Amounts (Reversal)                        .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I SET_DIST_STATUS               Sets Distribution Status                                    .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I SET_TAX_CORR_INFO             Sets Information for Input Tax Correction                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_BASE_DOC           I STORE                         Reverses the Document                                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I CALCULATE_TAX_CORR_BASE       Determines Basis for Input Tax Correction                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Basis for Input Tax Correction                       .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Basis for Input Tax Correction                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Gets Bases for Input Tax Correction                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Bases for Input Tax Correction with Additional Fields  .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager Using Higher-Level Object               .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I IS_UPTODATE                   Is Basis for Input Tax Correction Up-to-Date?               .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_BASE_MNGR     I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Basis for Input Tax Correction Using Key            .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I CALCULATE                     Calculates Input Tax Correction                             .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I CHECK_REVERSAL_ALLOWED        Checks If Reversal Is Possible for Correction Run           .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Do Correction Runs Exist?                                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I GET_CALC_LIST                 Gets List of Correction Results (Total)                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I GET_CALC_RES_LIST             Gets List of Correction Results (Items)                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I INIT                          Initializes Input Tax Correction Manager                    .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PROCESS               Initializes Manager for Calculation of Correction           .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_MNGR     I SET_REVERSAL_INDICATOR        Identifies Correction Run as Being Reversed                 .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_PARAM    I SET_OBJECT_LIST               Changes List of Objects to Be Processed                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_PARAM    I SET_PARAM                     Changes Parameter of Input Tax Correction                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_VARIANT  I CALCULATE                     Calculates Input Tax Correction [Final]                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_CALC_VARIANT  I CHECK_PRECONDITIONS           Checks If Prerequisites for Correction Are Met              .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_ACCOUNTING_OBJECT       Checks Account Assignment Object                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_CORR_PERIOD             Checks Correction Period                                    .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_FIRST_USE_DATE          Checks Date of First Use                                    .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_SERVICE_PERIOD          Checks Date of Service                                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_TCNO                    Checks Number of Correction Object                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_TCSTATUS                Checks Status of Correction Object                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_TCTYPE                  Checks Type of Correction Object                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I CHECK_XTC                     Checks Name of Correction Object                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I GET_ACCOUNTING_OBJECT         Gets Account Assignment Object                              .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I IS_ONETIME_CORRECTION         One-Time Correction?                                        .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_ACCOUNTING_OBJECT         Changes Account Assignment Object                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_CORR_PERIOD               Changes Correction Period                                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_FIRST_USE_DATE            Changes Date of First Use                                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_SERVICE_PERIOD            Changes Date of Service                                     .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_TCNO                      Changes Number of Correction Object                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_TCSTATUS                  Changes Status of Correction Object                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_TCTYPE                    Changes Type of Correction Object                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_CORR_OBJECT        I SET_XTC                       Changes Name of Correction Object                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I INIT_BY_DATA                  Initializes Document Using Data                             .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I INIT_BY_DETAIL                Initializes via Tax Breakdown Item                          .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I SET_DIST_AMOUNTS              Sets Distribution Amounts of Line                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I SET_DIST_STATUS               Sets Distribution Status of Line                            .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_DOC           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Structure                                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I DISTRIBUTE                    Executes Tax Breakdown                                      .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I INIT                          Initializes Manager                                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PROCESSID             Initializes Manager by Process ID                           .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I INIT_BY_TAX_DISTRIBUTION      Initializes Manager for Input Tax Distribution              .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I INIT_BY_TAX_DIST_DOC          Initializes Manager by Tax Breakdown Items                  .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I POST                          Posts Tax Breakdown                                         .
IF_REIT_TAX_DIST_MNGR          I REVERSE                       Reverses Tax Distribution                                   .
IF_REIT_TC_CALC_REV_PARAM      I SET_PARAM                     Sets Specific Parameters for Input Tax Correction           .
IF_REIT_TC_DOC_ITEM_ASSIGN     I CHECK_ITEM                    Checks Assignment to a Line Item                            .
IF_REIT_TC_DOC_ITEM_ASSIGN     I PROPOSE_ASSIGNMENT            Determines Proposal for Assignment of Correction Objects    .
IF_REIT_TC_DOC_ITEM_ASSIGN     I SELECT_DOC_ITEM_LIST          Gets List of Relevant Line Items                            .
IF_REIT_TC_MINOR_AMT_LIMIT     I ADJUST_RESULT                 Adjusts Results to Trivial Amount Limits, etc.              .
IF_REIT_TC_MINOR_AMT_LIMIT     I CHECK_PRECONDITION_FOR_CALC   Checks If Correction Should Be Run                          .
IF_REIT_TC_MINOR_AMT_LIMIT     I GET_CORRECTION_PERIOD         Gets Correction Period                                      .
IF_REIT_TC_MINOR_AMT_LIMIT     I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I GET_DATA                      Query Release Strategy and Status                           .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I GET_RESPONSIBLE               Determine Person Responsible for Release                    .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I INITIATE_RELEASE              Trigger Release/Reset Release                               .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I IS_REJECTION_ALLOWED          Rejection Possible?                                         .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I IS_RELEASE_ALLOWED            Release Possible?                                           .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I IS_RESET_REJ_ALLOWED          Cancellation of Rejection Allowed?                          .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I IS_RESET_REL_ALLOWED          Cancellation of Release Possible?                           .
IF_RELEASABLE_MM               I REJECT                        Reject                                                      .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I CAN_RELEASE                   Release Possible?                                           .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I CAN_RESET_RELEASE             Cancellation of Release Possible                            .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I GET_INDICATOR                 Release Indicator                                           .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I GET_STATE                     Query Release Status                                        .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I GET_STRATEGY                  Strategy                                                    .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I IS_RELEASED                   Released?                                                   .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I RELEASE                       Release                                                     .
IF_RELEASE_STATE_MM            I RESET_RELEASE                 Cancel Release                                              .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MANAGER_MM I DEREGISTER                    Register Strategy Object                                    .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MANAGER_MM I GET_STRATEGY                  Strategy Object                                             .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MANAGER_MM I REGISTER                      Register Strategy Object                                    .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I DETERMINE_INDICATOR           Release Indicator and Relevance from Status Object          .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I GET_CODES_FOR_RELEASE         Codes That Can Effect Release                               .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I GET_CODES_FROM_STATE          Codes That Have Released                                    .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I GET_INFO                      Complete Information re Release Strategy                    .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I GET_INFO_FOR_CODE             Details re Release Code                                     .
IF_RELEASE_STRATEGY_MM         I PROPAGATE_STATE               Release/Cancel Release                                      .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Land Register                                       .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Returns a Land Register                                     .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns a Land Register with Additional Data                .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Returns Land Registers                                      .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Land Registers with Additional Data                 .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds New Land Register                                      .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Sets Complete List                                          .
IF_RELM_JL_LR_REL_MNGR         I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Land Register                                       .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I CHECK_JLNO                    Checks Joint Liability Number                               .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I CHECK_VALID_PERIOD            Checks Validity Period                                      .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I CHECK_XJL                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_JLNO                      Gets Joint Liability Number                                 .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_LR_REL_MNGR               Gets Manager for Assigned Land Registers                    .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Valid-To Date                                          .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I GET_XJL                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I SET_JLNO                      Sets Joint Liability Number                                 .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Valid-To Date                                          .
IF_RELM_JOINT_LIABILITY        I SET_XJL                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_LRDISTRICT              Checks Land Register District                               .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_LRNOOLD                 Checks Old Land Register Number                             .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_LRPAGENO                Checks Page Number                                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_LRTYPE                  Checks Land Register Type                                   .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_LRVOLUMENO              Checks Volume Number                                        .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Closure Date                                         .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I CHECK_XLR                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LAND_REGISTRY             Gets Land Registry                                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LAND_REGISTRY_X           Gets Land Registry with Additional Data                     .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LRDISTRICT                Gets Land Register District                                 .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LRPAGENO                  Gets Page Number                                            .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LRTYPE                    Gets Land Register Type                                     .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LRVOLUMENO                Gets Volume Number                                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR          Gets Manager for Rights and Easements                       .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LR_JL_REL_MNGR            Gets Manager for Joint Liabilities                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR        Gets Processing Number Manager                              .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_LR_SEC1_MNGR              Gets Manager for Section 1                                  .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_RE_REGISTER_MNGR          Gets Real Estate Register                                   .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Closure Date                                           .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I GET_XLR                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I IS_HERITABLE_BUILDING_RIGHT   Is Land Register a Leasehold Land Register?                 .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_LRDISTRICT                Sets Land Register District                                 .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_LRNOOLD                   Sets Old Land Register Number                               .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_LRPAGENO                  Sets Page Number                                            .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_LRTYPE                    Sets Land Register Type                                     .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_LRVOLUMENO                Sets Volume Number                                          .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Closure Date                                           .
IF_RELM_LAND_REGISTER          I SET_XLR                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_GET                 Gets Assigned Land                                          .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_GET_X               Gets Assigned Land with Additional Fields                   .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_SET                 Sets Assigned Land                                          .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHECK_BEFORE_DELETE           Checks If an Entry Is Allowed to Be Deleted (User)          .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHECK_SECNO                   Checks Correctness of a Single Section Number(with ConvExit).
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CONTRACTS_GET                 Gets Real Estate Contracts                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CONTRACTS_GET_X               Gets Real Estate Contracts with Additional Fields           .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CONTRACTS_SET                 Sets Real Estate Contracts                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Processing Number                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Fields                     .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Fields                      .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR         Gets Rights and Easements - Changes                         .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I LOANS_GET                     Gets Loan                                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I LOANS_GET_X                   Gets Loan with Additional Fields                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I LOANS_SET                     Sets Loan                                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I PARTNER_GET                   Gets Partner                                                .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I PARTNER_GET_X                 Gets Partner with Additional Fields                         .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I PARTNER_SET                   Sets Partner                                                .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I REFRESH                       Setting of Automatically Filled Values                      .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I UPDATE_DATES                  Updates the Entry/Cancellation Date of All Entries          .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_LR_EASEMENT_MNGR       I UPDATE_ENTRY_DATE             Updates Entry Date of Entry                                 .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_REL_GET                   Gets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_REL_GET_X                 Gets Additions to Land Register with Addit. Fields          .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_REL_SET                   Sets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_SEC_GET                   Gets Changes - Section Numbers                              .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_SEC_GET_X                 Gets Changes - Section Numbers with Additional Fields       .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHG_SEC_SET                   Sets Changes - Section Numbers                              .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Data                       .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Returns All Entries                                         .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Returns All Entries with Additional Data                    .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_EM_CHANGE_MNGR      I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I CREATE_JL_FOR_EASEMENT        Generates New Joint Liability for Land Register Entry       .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I DELETE_JL_FOR_EASEMENT        Deletes Joint Liability for Land Register Entry             .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I GET_JL                        Returns All Current Joint Liabilities                       .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I GET_JL_BY_JLNO                Returns Joint Liability (from Buffer)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I GET_JL_FOR_EASEMENT           Gets Joint Liability for Land Register Entry                .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_LR_JL_REL_MNGR         I SET_JL_FOR_EASEMENT           Sets Joint Liability for Land Register Entry                .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Processing Number                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL                    Returns a Processing Number                                 .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Returns Processing Numbers                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Processing Number                                .
IF_RELM_LR_PROCESS_NO_MNGR     I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Processing Number                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I ADDITIONS_GET                 Gets Added Land (Parcels)                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I ADDITIONS_SET                 Sets Added Land (Parcels)                                   .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Fields                     .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_ADDITION          Gets All Entries for a Piece of Land That Was Added To      .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Fields                      .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I SET_OWNER                     Sets the Owner for an Entry                                 .
IF_RELM_LR_SEC1_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Fields                     .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Fields                      .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_MEASUREMENTS              Gets Area Comparison for Notice of Assessment               .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_MEAS_COUNT                Return Number of Entries for Space Comparison               .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_PL_TOTALS                 Gets Area of Assigned Parcels on Key Date                   .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies                                                    .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_NA_VALUE_MNGR          I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_FILENO                  Checks Internal File Number                                 .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_ISCOLL                  Checks Collective Notice                                    .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_NANO                    Checks Number of Notice of Assessment                       .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_NANOOLD                 Checks Old Number of Notice of Assessment                   .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Cessation Date                                       .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I CHECK_XNA                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_FILENO                    Gets Internal File Number                                   .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_ISCOLL                    Gets Collective Notice                                      .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_NANO                      Gets Number of Notice of Assessment                         .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_NANOOLD                   Gets Old Number of Notice of Assessment                     .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_NA_VALUE_MNGR             Gets Manager for Assessed Value Manager                     .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I GET_XNA                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_FILENO                    Sets Internal File Number                                   .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_ISCOLL                    Sets Collective Notice                                      .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_NANO                      Sets Number of Notice of Assessment                         .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_NANOOLD                   Sets Old Number of Notice of Assessment                     .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Validity Date                                          .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_NOTICE_ASSESSMENT      I SET_XNA                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_GSBER                   Checks Business Area                                        .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_LOCHIER                 Checks Location Key                                         .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_PLNO                    Checks Parcel of Land                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_PLSUBDIVNO              Checks Number of Tract of Land Containing Parcel            .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_PLSURVEYIND             Checks Surveying Status                                     .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Valid-From Date                                      .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Cessation Date                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I CHECK_XPL                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_DEFAULT_LOCSYS            Gets Default Location Structure of Parcel                   .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_GSBER                     Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_LOCHIER                   Gets Location Key                                           .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_PLISTEMPORARY             Gets Temporary Parcel                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_PLSURVEYIND               Gets Surveying Status                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_PL_MAP_MNGR               Gets Manager for Parcel Maps for Parcel                     .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_PL_SLIDE_MNGR             Gets Manager for Overlays for Parcel                        .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_PL_USAGE_MNGR             Gets Manager for Usage and Development                      .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_SURVEY_OFFICE             Gets Survey Office                                          .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_SURVEY_OFFICE_X           Gets Survey Office with Additional Data                     .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I GET_XPL                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_GSBER                     Sets Business Area                                          .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_LOCHIER                   Sets Location Key                                           .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_PLISTEMPORARY             Sets Temporary Parcel                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_PLNO                      Sets Parcel of Land                                         .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_PLSUBDIVNO                Sets Number of Tract of Land Containing Parcel              .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_PLSURVEYIND               Sets Surveying Status                                       .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PARCEL_OF_LAND         I SET_XPL                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR      I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHANGE_EASEMENT_SET           Sets Change of Easement                                     .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CHECK_PEERNO                  Checks Correctness of Single RE Register Number (w/ConvExit).
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I CREATE_CHANGE_ON_EASEMENT     Create Change of Easement Using Sequence Number             .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I DELETE_DELETION               Cancels Deletion                                            .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I DOM_PARCELS_OF_LAND_GET       Gets Dominant Tenements                                     .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I DOM_PARCELS_OF_LAND_SET       Sets Dominant Tenements                                     .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR       I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I REFRESH                       Cleanup of Lists                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_MAP_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_POSSIBLE_SLIDES           Gets Possible Overlays                                      .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I GET_POSSIBLE_SLIDE_CLASS      Gets Possible Classifications of Overlays                   .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I REFRESH                       Cleanup of Lists                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I SET_LIST                      Sets All Entries                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_SLIDE_MNGR          I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I CHECK_DETAIL                  Check a Line                                                .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (T/F)                                .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry with Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Data                        .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I REFRESH                       Cleanup of Lists                                            .
IF_RELM_PL_USAGE_MNGR          I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_CONTAMINATED_SITE       Checks Data of Contamination                                .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_DEVELOPMENT_PLAN        Checks Data of Development Plan                             .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_EASEMENT_REGISTER       Checks Data of Easement Register                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_LOCHIER                 Checks Location Key                                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_NON_HAZARDOUS_WASTE     Checks Data of Non-Hazardous Waste                          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PECHANGEDATE            Checks Date of Chage Lock                                   .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PECSNO                  Checks Number of Contamination/Non-Hazardous Waste          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEDPNO                  Checks Number of Development Plan                           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEEFFECTDATE            Checks Effective Date                                       .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEERPAGENO              Checks Page Number in Easement Register                     .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEID                    Checks ID of Other Public Register                          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PELASTMODDATE           Checks Date of Last Change                                  .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEPLANDATE              Checks Date of Planning/Decision                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEPREDPNO               Checks Preliminary Procedure for Development Plan           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEPSNO                  Checks Number of Site Protection                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEPSTYPE                Checks Type of Site Protection                              .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PEREVOCDATE             Checks Date of Revocation                                   .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PESTATEMENTDATE         Checks Date of Opinion Statement                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PETYPE                  Checks Type of Other Public Register                        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_PROTECTED_SITE          Checks Data of Site Protection                              .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_RGRNART                 Checks Building Usage Type According to Land Use Map        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I CHECK_XPE                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_DEFAULT_LOCSYS            Gets Default Location Structure of Parcel                   .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_LOCHIER                   Gets Location Key                                           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PECHANGEDATE              Gets Planning/Decision Date                                 .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PECSNO                    Gets Number of Contamination/Non-Hazardous Waste            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEDPNO                    Gets Development Plan Number                                .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEEFFECTDATE              Gets Effective Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEERPAGENO                Gets Page Number of Easement Register                       .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEID                      Gets ID of Other Public Register                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PELASTMODDATE             Gets Effective Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEPLANDATE                Gets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEPREDPNO                 Gets Preliminary Procedure for Development Plan             .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEPSNO                    Gets Number of Site Protection                              .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEPSTYPE                  Gets Type of Site Protection                                .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PEREVOCDATE               Gets Revocation Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PESTATEMENTDATE           Gets Date of Change Lock                                    .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PETYPE                    Gets Type of Other Public Register                          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PE_CONT_SITE_MNGR         Gets Manager for Contamination/Non-Hazardous Waste          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_PE_EASEMENT_MNGR          Gets Manager for Easement                                   .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_RGRNART                   Gets Usage Type of Land According to Land Use Map           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I GET_XPE                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_LOCHIER                   Sets Location Key                                           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PECHANGEDATE              Sets Planning/Decision Date                                 .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PECSNO                    Sets Number of Contamination/Non-Hazardous Waste            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEDPNO                    Sets Number of Development Plan                             .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEEFFECTDATE              Sets Effective Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEERPAGENO                Sets Page Number of Easement Register                       .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEID                      Sets ID of Other Public Register                            .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PELASTMODDATE             Sets Effective Date                                         .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEPLANDATE                Sets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEPREDPNO                 Sets Preliminary Procedure for Development Plan             .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEPSNO                    Sets Number of Site Protection                              .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEPSTYPE                  Sets Type of Site Protection                                .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PEREVOCDATE               Sets Revocation Date                                        .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PESTATEMENTDATE           Sets Date of Change Lock                                    .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_PETYPE                    Sets Type of Other Public Register                          .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_RGRNART                   Sets Usage Type of Land According to Land Use Map           .
IF_RELM_PUBLIC_ENCUMBRANCE     I SET_XPE                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I DELETE_SEQNO                  Deletes Partial Entries of Parcel Update (SEQNO)            .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Fields                     .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Returns Entries                                             .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Returns Entries with Additional Fields                      .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I UPDATE_CHILDREN               Update Parcels                                              .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Entry                                               .
IF_RELM_RC_PL_REL_MNGR         I UPDATE_PARENT                 Updates Parent Object                                       .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_MEASCHANGE              Checks Differences Between Cadastral Areas                  .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_MEASDIFF                Checks Surveying Difference                                 .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_MEASUNIT                Checks Measurement Unit                                     .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_RCCATEGORY              Checks Parcel Update Category                               .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_RCNO                    Checks Number of Parcel Update                              .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_SURVEYOFFICE            Checks Number of Survey Office                              .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Valid-From Date                                      .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Cessation Date                                       .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I CHECK_XRC                     Checks Name                                                 .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_MEASCHANGE                Gets Differences Between Cadastral Areas                    .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_MEASDIFF                  Gets Surveying Difference                                   .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_MEASUNIT                  Gets Measurement Unit                                       .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_RCCATEGORY                Gets Parcel Update Category                                 .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_RCNO                      Gets Number of Parcel Update                                .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_RC_PL_MNGR                Gets Manager for Changes to Holdings                        .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_SURVEYOFFICE              Gets Survey Office                                          .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_SURVEY_OFFICE             Gets Survey Office                                          .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_SURVEY_OFFICE_X           Gets Survey Office Additional Data                          .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I GET_XRC                       Gets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_MEASCHANGE                Sets Difference Between Cadastral Areas                     .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_MEASDIFF                  Sets Surveying Difference                                   .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_MEASUNIT                  Sets Measurement Unit                                       .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_RCCATEGORY                Sets Parcel Update Category                                 .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_RCNO                      Sets Number of Parcel Update                                .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_SURVEYOFFICE              Sets Survey Office                                          .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets Valid-From Date                                        .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets Cessation Date                                         .
IF_RELM_RECORD_CHANGE          I SET_XRC                       Sets Name                                                   .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_GET                 Gets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_GET_X               Gets Additions to Land Register with Addit. Fields          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I ADDITIONS_SET                 Sets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I BUS_TYPES_GET                 Gets Land Use Types                                         .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I BUS_TYPES_SET                 Sets Land Use Types                                         .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I BUS_TYPES_SUM_GET             Gets Total of Land Use Types                                .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I CHECK_BEFORE_DELETE           Checks If an Entry Is Allowed to Be Deleted (User)          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I CHECK_LRREGNO                 Checks Correctness of Single RE Register Number (w/ConvExit).
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes RER Entry                                           .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I DT_ADDITIONS_GET              Gets Additions RRt                                          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I DT_ADDITIONS_SET              Sets Additions RRt                                          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I DT_SERVING_GET                Gets Servient Tenements RRt                                 .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I DT_SERVING_SET                Sets Servient Tenements RRt                                 .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_DESCRIPTION_FOR_ENTRY     Gets Description of an Entry (Multiple Subentries)          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Entry in Real Estate Register                       .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns Entry in Real Estate Register with Addit. Data      .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Returns the Real Estate Register                            .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_LIST_AS_ADDITIONS         Gets RER as Land (Parcels) (RER Numbers Only)               .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Returns the Real Estate Register with Additional Data       .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR         Gets Real Estate Register: Additions/Removals               .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds New RER Entry                                          .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I REFRESH                       Setting of Automatically Filled Values                      .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I RG_OLD_GET                    Gets Old RE Register Numbers                                .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I RG_OLD_SET                    Sets Old RE Register Numbers                                .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I SET_CANCEL_DATE               Sets Cancellation Date of Entry                             .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I SET_HERITOWNER                Sets Owner of Leasehold Land for Entry                      .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I UPDATE_BUSTYPES_BY_PL         System Date Updates Land Use Types Using Parcel             .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I UPDATE_DATES                  Updates Cancellation or Entry Date of All Entries           .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes RER Entry                                           .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I UPDATE_MEASVALUE_BY_BT        Updates Measurement Amount Using Land Types                 .
IF_RELM_RE_REGISTER_MNGR       I UPDATE_MEASVALUE_BY_PL        Updates Measurement Amount Using Parcel                     .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I CHECK_KEY                     Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I EXISTS                        Checks Whether Entry Exists (Except.)                       .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Returns an Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Returns an Entry with Additional Data                       .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Returns All Entries                                         .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Returns All Entries with Additional Data                    .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds a New Entry                                            .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_ADD_GET                   Gets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_ADD_GET_X                 Gets Additions to Land Register with Addit. Fields          .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_ADD_SET                   Sets Additions to Land Register                             .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_SUB_GET                   Gets Removals from Land Register                            .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_SUB_GET_X                 Gets Removals from Land Register with Additional Fields     .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I REL_SUB_SET                   Sets Removals from Land Register                            .
IF_RELM_RE_RG_CHANGE_MNGR      I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes an Entry                                            .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I CAN_PERFORM                   Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I CHECK_BEFORE_PERFORM          Checks Before Execution                                     .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I FREE                          Releases all resources and locks [Final]                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I GET_MSGLIST                   Gets the Message Collector                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of the Migration                                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I GET_TEXT                      Text of a Settlement Step [Abstract]                        .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I INIT                          Initializes Using the Superordinate Object [Final]          .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I IS_MSGLIST_EMPTY              Is the List of Collected Messages Empty?                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I IS_STATUS_MODIFIED            Checks if data was changed [Final]                          .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I PERFORM                       Execution of Migration [Final]                              .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status of the Migration                            .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_ANY            I STORE_STATUS                  Save Status [Final]                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I CAN_PERFORM                   Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I CHECK_BEFORE_PERFORM          Checks Before Execution                                     .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I GET_MSGLIST                   Gets the Message Collector                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I GET_MSGLIST_BY_TAB            Gets the Message Collector for a Table                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of the Migration                                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I GET_STATUS_LIST               Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I INIT                          Initializes Using the Superordinate Object [Final]          .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I IS_MSGLIST_EMPTY              Is the List of Collected Messages Empty?                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I PERFORM                       Execution of Migration [Final]                              .
IF_REMI_MIGRATE_GROUP          I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status of the Migration                            .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I CAN_PERFORM                   Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I CAN_PERFORM_BY_STEP           Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_LIST_EXECUTEABLE_STEPS    Gets All Possible Steps That Can Be Executed                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_MSGLIST                   Gets the Message Collector                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_MSGLIST_BY_GROUP          Gets the Message Collector for a Group                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_MSGLIST_BY_STEP           Gets the Message Collector for a Step                       .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_MSGLIST_BY_TAB            Gets the Message Collector for a Table                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_POSSIBLE_STATUS_LIST      Gets the Possible Statuses of a Step                        .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of the Migration                                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS_BY_GROUP           Gets the Status of Migration for a Group                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS_BY_STEP            Gets the Status of Migration for a Step                     .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS_LIST               Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS_LIST_BY_GROUP      Gets the Status of a Group                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STATUS_LIST_BY_STEP       Gets the Status of a Step                                   .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I GET_STEP                      Gets a Certain Step                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I IS_MSGLIST_EMPTY              Is the List of Collected Messages Empty?                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I IS_STORABLE                   Checks If Saving Is Allowed                                 .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I PERFORM                       Execution of Migration                                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I PERFORM_STEP                  Execution of a Step                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION              I SET_STATUS_BY_STEP            Sets the Status of Migration for a Step                     .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I CAN_PERFORM                   Can Be Executed                                             .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I CHECK_BEFORE_PERFORM          Checks Before Execution                                     .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_GROUP                     Gets a Group                                                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_MSGLIST                   Gets the Message Collector                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_MSGLIST_BY_GROUP          Gets the Message Collector for a Group                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_MSGLIST_BY_TAB            Gets the Message Collector for a Table                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_POSSIBLE_STATUS_LIST      Gets the Possible States                                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of the Migration                                .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_STATUS_BY_GROUP           Gets the Status of Migration for a Group                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_STATUS_LIST               Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I GET_STATUS_LIST_BY_GROUP      Gets the Status of a Group                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I INIT                          Initialize                                                  .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I IS_MSGLIST_EMPTY              Is the List of Collected Messages Empty?                    .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I PERFORM                       Execution of Migration                                      .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP         I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status of the Migration                            .
IF_REMI_MIGRATION_STEP_TRREQ   I ADD_OBJECTS_TO_REQUEST        Adds Table Entries to Transport Request                     .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I GET_CONDCURR                  Currency of Condition [Abstract]                            .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I GET_COND_OBJNR                Gets Object Number for the Condition                        .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I GET_COND_OBJNRDIST            Distribution Object                                         .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I GET_DISTRULE                  Supplies the Distribution Formula                           .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I GET_UPDATED_BUSOBJ            Gets the Updated BO [Abstract]                              .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I INIT_BY_KEY                   Initializes Manager Using Key Fields [Final]                .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I MIGRATION_CONDITION           Migration of Condition [Final]                              .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I SET_BPOBJREL                  Primary Business Partner                                    .
IF_REMI_MIG_COND_MNGR          I SET_VIMI38                    Sets Cost Center Assignment                                 .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I GET_CC_SOURCE                 Gets the Source Company Code                                .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I GET_CC_TARGET                 Gets the Target Company Code                                .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I GET_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR    Gets the Manager - House Bank Accounts                      .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I IS_CREATED_CC_TARGET          Was the Target Company Code Generated?                      .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I IS_ERROR_ACTIVATION_ENABLED   Activation Allowed Despite Error?                           .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I IS_HAS_ACTIVE                 Is the Owner of the Manager Active?                         .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I IS_MODIFIED_CC_SOURCE         Was the Source Company Code Changed?                        .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I RAISE_EVENT_CC_SOURCE_CHANGED Generates Event Source Company Code Change                  .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I RAISE_EVENT_PARTER_CHANGED    Generates Event Partner Change                              .
IF_REMM_HAS_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT  I SET_UPDATE_CCREF              Sets the Update Indicator                                   .
IF_REMM_HAS_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN      I GET_MN_COMPANY_CODE           Gets the Company Code                                       .
IF_REMM_HAS_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN      I GET_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR        Gets the Manager - Objects for Third Party Management       .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If House Bank Account Exists (Except.)               .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I COUNT                         Gets Number of House Bank Accounts                          .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I COUNT_PARTNER_BANK            Returns the Number of Parnter Banks                         .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes House Bank Account                                  .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I EXISTS                        Checks If House Bank Account Exists (Y/N)                   .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_DEFAULT                   Gets the Active House Bank                                  .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Additional Data                     .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_LIST                      Gets All House Bank Accounts                                .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_LIST_X                    Gets All House Bank Accounts with Additional Data           .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I GET_PARTNER_BANK              Gets the Partner Banks                                      .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager Using Superordinate Object              .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds House Bank Account                                     .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I INSERT_PARTNER_BANK           Adds Partner Banks                                          .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I IS_BANK_ACCOUNT_USABLE        Asks If Account Can Be Used in Own Context                  .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I IS_EXTERNAL_NR_HOUSEBANK      Asks If Number Assignment for House Banks Is External       .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I SET_BANKDEFAULT               Sets the Default Bank Details                               .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I SET_LIST                      Sets All House Bank Accounts                                .
IF_REMM_HOUSEBANK_ACCOUNT_MNGR I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Updates House Bank Account                                  .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_CCCR                    Checks the Condominium Owner Company Code                   .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_CCMNG                   Checks the Manager Company Code                             .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_CCREF                   Checks the Reference Company Code                           .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_HASTAXDIST              Checks the Opting Indicator                                 .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_MANDATEID               Checks the Mandate ID                                       .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_MANDATEOLD              Checks the Old Mandate Number                               .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_MANDATETYPE             Checks the Mandate Type                                     .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_STCEG                   Checks the VAT Registration Number                          .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks the Valid-From Date of Mandate                       .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks the Valid-To Date of Mandate                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I CHECK_XMANDATE                Checks the Name of the Mandate                              .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I ENABLE_ERROR_ACTIVATION       Allows Activation Despite Incorrect Data                    .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_BEHAVIOURMNGM             Gets Company Code Behavior                                  .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_CCCR                      Gets the Condominium Owner Company Code                     .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_CCMNG                     Gets the Manager Company Code                               .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_CCREF                     Gets the Reference Company Code                             .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_HASTAXDIST                Gets the Opting Indicator                                   .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_MANDATEID                 Gets the Mandate ID                                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_MANDATEOLD                Gets the Old Mandate Number                                 .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_MANDATETYPE               Gets the Mandate Type                                       .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_STCEG                     Gets the VAT Registration Number                            .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets the Valid-From Date of Mandate                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_VALIDTO                   Gets the Valid-To Date of Mandate                           .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I GET_XMANDATE                  Gets Name of Mandate                                        .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I IS_ACTIVE                     Asks If Mandate Is Active?                                  .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_BEHAVIOURMNGM             Sets Company Code Behavior                                  .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_CCCR                      Sets the Condominium Owner Company Code                     .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_CCMNG                     Sets the Manager Company Code                               .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_CCREF                     Sets the Reference Company Code                             .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_HASTAXDIST                Sets the Opting Indicator                                   .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_MANDATEID                 Sets the Mandate ID                                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_MANDATEOLD                Sets the Old Mandate Number                                 .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_MANDATETYPE               Sets the Mandate Type                                       .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_STCEG                     Sets the VAT Registration Number                            .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_UPDATE_FROM_CCREF         Sets the Update Indicator                                   .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_VALIDFROM                 Sets the Valid-From Date of Mandate                         .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_VALIDTO                   Sets the Valid-To Date of Mandate                           .
IF_REMM_MANDATE                I SET_XMANDATE                  Sets Name of Mandate                                        .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I ADD_LIST_BUSOBJ               Adds Data of Business Object to List                        .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I CHECK_ADOPT_OBJECTS           Checks the Object to Be Transferred                         .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I CHECK_OBJ_ASSIGN_CCMN         Gets Flag for If There Is Assignment in Mandate Company Code.
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I CHECK_SETTINGS_CC_INVOLVED    Checks Settings of Company Codes Involved                   .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I GET_CC_FROM_LIST              Gets the Company Code of the Object List                    .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I GET_FLAG_EXT_NUMBER           Gets Flags for If Number Assignmt for Object Types Internal .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I GET_LIST                      Gets All Objects to Be Transferred                          .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I GET_LIST_X                    Gets All Objects to Be Transferred and Addit. Fields        .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I INIT_BY_MANDATE               Initializes Using Mandates                                  .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I SET_FLAG_EXT_NUMBER           Sets Flags for If Number Assignmt for Object Types Internal .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I SET_LIST                      Sets List of All Objects to Be Transferred                  .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I SET_OBJ_VALIDFROM             Sets Date Starting on Which the Objects Are Valid           .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I SET_PARAMETER_MANDATE         Sets Parameters of Mandate                                  .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ADOPT           I STORE_ADOPTION                Saves the Objects to Be Transferred                         .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_BUILDING                  Gets Buildings                                              .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_BUSINESS_ENTITY           Gets Business Entities                                      .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_COMPANY_CODE              Gets Company Codes                                          .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_OBJECT                    Gets the Assigned Object                                    .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_OBJECT_X                  Gets the Assigned Object                                    .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I GET_PROPERTY                  Gets the Land                                               .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager Using Superordinate Object              .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I IS_ENABLED                    Asks If Assignment Is Allowed                               .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I SET_OBJECT                    Sets the Assigned Object                                    .
IF_REMM_MN_OBJ_ASSIGN_MNGR     I SET_OBJECT_IDENT_FOR_CHECK    Sets the Assigned Object                                    .
IF_REOR_HAS_OBJECT_STATUS      I GET_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR        Gets the Search Status Manager                              .
IF_REOR_HAS_OBJECT_STATUS      I GET_SEARCH_RESULT             Gets the Objects Found                                      .
IF_REOR_HAS_OBJECT_STATUS      I SEARCH                        Find                                                        .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I DELETE                        Removes Status                                              .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Checks If Search Status Exists                              .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Single Status                                          .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Supplies List of Objects                                    .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I GET_LIST_BY_OBJSTATUS         Gets the List of Objects for a Status                       .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies List of Objects                                    .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Search Status Manager Using Superordinate Object.
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts New Status                                          .
IF_REOR_OBJECT_STATUS_MNGR     I SET_LIST                      Sets List of Objects                                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I ADOPT_DATA                    Transfer Data                                               .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_INDUSTRY                Checks Industry                                             .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_OFID                    Checks Offer Number                                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNBUKRSCOLLECT        Checks Company Code of Main Contract                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNCURR                Checks Contract Currency                                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNDAT                 Checks Date of Conclusion of Contract                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNNRCOLLECT           Checks Number of Main Contract                              .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNTLAW                Checks Tenancy Law                                          .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_RECNTYPE                Checks Contract Type                                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_SRRELEVANT              Checks 'Sales-Relevant' Indicator                           .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I CHECK_XOF                     Checks Name of Offer                                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Gets Structure with Basic Data (Original DB Data)           .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_ADJUSTMENT_MNGR      Supplies Adjustment Term Manager (Terms)                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_NOTICE_MNGR          Supplies Notice Manager (Terms)                             .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_NOTICE_OBJ_MNGR      Supplies Notice Manager for Objects (Terms)                 .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_PAYMENT_MNGR         Supplies Payment Rule Manager (Terms)                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_PERIOD_MNGR          Supplies Term Manager (Terms)                               .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_RENEWAL_MNGR         Supplies the Renewal Manager (Terms)                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_RENEWAL_OBJ_MNGR     Gets Renewal Manager for Objects (Terms)                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_RHYTHM_MNGR          Supplies Frequency Term Manager (Terms)                     .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_TERM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR Gets the Withholding Tax Manager (Terms)                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I GET_USERSUPPLIER              Supplies Contractor and Contractee                          .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I IS_DIRECTION_SUPPLIER         Asks If Contract Is an Offering Contract                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I IS_DIRECTION_USER             Asks If Contract Is a Using Contract                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I IS_INTERN                     Asks If Internal Contract Is Involved                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I IS_REJECTED                   Was Contract Offer Rejected                                 .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_BUKRS                     Changes the Company Code                                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_INDUSTRY                  Changes the Industry                                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_OFRESTO                   Changes 'Reserved To' Date                                  .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNBUKRSCOLLECT          Changes Company Code of Main Contract                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNCNCURR                Changes Contract Currency                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNDAT                   Changes Date of Contract Conclusion                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNNR                    Changes Contract                                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNNRCOLLECT             Changes Number of Main Contract                             .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_RECNTLAW                  Changes Tenancy Law                                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_SRRELEVANT                Changes Relevance to Sales-Based Rent                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER                  I SET_XOF                       Changes Name of Contract Offer                              .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_ADDRESS                   Supplies the Address                                        .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_AECCLASSSTR               Gets the AEC Level String                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_CONDITION_LIST            Gets List of Conditions                                     .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_MEAS_LIST                 Gets List of Measurements                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I GET_RRCHARACTSTR              Gets the Fixtures/Fittings Characteristic String            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I HAS_GENERIC_AEC_CLASS         Bool: General Characteristic "Publicly Subsidized" Exists?  .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_ADDRESS                   Sets the Address                                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_AECCLASSSTR               Sets the AEC Level String                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_BENO                      Sets the Business Entity                                    .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_BUILDYEAR                 Sets the Construction Year                                  .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_BUKRS                     Sets the Company Code                                       .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_BUNO                      Sets the Building                                           .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_CONDITION                 Sets the Conditions                                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_FLOOR                     Sets the Floor                                              .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_MEAS                      Sets the Measurement Type                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_MEASUREMENT               Sets Measurements                                           .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_NEIGHBORHOOD              Sets Fields for Neighborhood                                .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OFID                      Sets ID of Contract Offer                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OOBEG                     Sets Available From                                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OODATAFROM                Sets Valid-From Date of Offer Data                          .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OODATATO                  Sets Valid-To Date of Offer Data                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OOEND                     Sets Available To                                           .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_OORESTO                   Sets Reserved To                                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_PRNO                      Sets Land                                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_RONO                      Sets Number of the Rental Object                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_RRCHARACTSTR              Sets the Fixtures/Fittings Characteristic String            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_SLAGEWE                   Sets Location of Business Entity                            .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_SOBJLAGE                  Sets the District Location                                  .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_SSTDORT                   Sets the Regional Location                                  .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_TRANSPCONN                Sets the Transport Connections                              .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_USAGETYPE                 Sets the Usage Type                                         .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_USAGE_OBJECT              Sets the Reference Object                                   .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I SET_XOO                       Changes Text for Offered Object                             .
IF_REOR_OFFER_OBJECT           I UPDATE_DATA                   Updates the Data                                            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_AEC                     Checks Accommodation Entitlement Certificate                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_BUILDAGE                Checks Age of Building                                      .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_COND                    Checks 'Maximum Amount for Condition Group'                 .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_EDITINDICATOR           Checks Processing Indicator                                 .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_EDITSTATUS              Checks Processing Status                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_INFLOWFROM              Checks Source of Prospect                                   .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_INFLOWREASON            Checks Reason for Search                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_INFLOWWAY               Checks Source of Inquiry                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_MEAS                    Checks Measurements                                         .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_NEIGHBORHOODSTR         Checks Neighborhood                                         .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_PRESELECTION            Checks Preselection Indicator                               .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRCHARACTSTR            Checks Fixtures and Fittings                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRCNBEG                 Checks Contract Start Date                                  .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRCNBEGLATER            Checks 'Later Contract Start Possible'                      .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRCNEND                 Checks Contract End Date                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRDISTLOCSTR            Checks District Location                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRFLOORSTR              Checks Floor                                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRID                    Checks Number of RE Search Request                          .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRLOCATIONSTR           Checks Location                                             .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRREGLOCSTR             Checks Regional Location                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRSEARCHPART            Checks Inclusion in Search                                  .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRTRANSPCONNSTR         Checks Transport Connections                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_RRTYPE                  Checks RE Search Request Type                               .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I CHECK_XRR                     Checks Text of RE Search Request                            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_AECCLASSSTR               Gets the AEC Level String                                   .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_BUSINESS_ENTITY_LIST      Gets Business Entities for RE Search Request                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_CONDITION_LIST            Gets List of Conditions                                     .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_MEAS_LIST                 Gets List of Measurements                                   .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_NEIGHBORHOODSTR           Gets the Neighborhood String                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRCHARACTSTR              Gets the Fixtures/Fittings Characteristic String            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRDISTLOCSTR              Gets the District Location String                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRFLOORSTR                Gets the Floor String                                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRLOCATIONNESTR           Gets Exclude Location String                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRLOCATIONSTR             Gets the Location String                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRREGLOCSTR               Gets the Regional Location String                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I GET_RRTRANSPCONNSTR           Gets the Transport Connections String                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I HAS_GENERIC_AEC_CLASS         Bool: General Characteristic "Publicly Subsidized" Exists?  .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I IS_AEC_POSSIBLE               Bool: Accommodation Entitlement Certificate Possible?       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_ADDRESS                   Sets the Address                                            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECCLASSSTR               Sets the AEC Level String                                   .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECDATEOFISSUE            Sets AEC Issued On                                          .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECEXISTS                 Sets AEC Exists                                             .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECINFO                   Sets AEC Info                                               .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECPERSONGROUP            Sets AEC Person Group                                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECPRIORITY               Sets AEC Priority                                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_AECVALIDTO                Sets AEC Valid-To                                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_BUILDAGEFROM              Sets Construction Year From                                 .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_BUILDAGETO                Sets Construction Year To                                   .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_BUSINESS_ENTITY_LIST      Sets Business Entities for RE Search Request                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_CONDITION                 Sets the Conditions                                         .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_EDITINDICATOR             Sets the Processing Indicator                               .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_EDITSTATUS                Sets the Processing Status                                  .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_INFLOWFROM                Sets Source of Prospect                                     .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_INFLOWREASON              Sets Reason for Search                                      .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_INFLOWWAY                 Sets Source of Inquiry                                      .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_MEAS                      Sets the Measurements                                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_NEIGHBORHOODSTR           Sets the Neighborhood String                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_PRESELECTION              Sets the Preselection Indicator                             .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRCHARACTSTR              Sets the Fixtures/Fittings Characteristic String            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRCNBEG                   Sets Requested Contract Start Date                          .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRCNBEGLATER              Sets 'Later Contract Start Possible'                        .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRCNEND                   Sets Requested Contract End Date                            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRDISTLOCSTR              Sets the District Location String                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRFLOORSTR                Sets the Floor String                                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRID                      Sets the RE Search Request Number                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRLOCATIONNESTR           Sets Exclude-Location String                                .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRLOCATIONSTR             Sets the Location String                                    .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRREGLOCSTR               Sets the Regional Location String                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRSEARCHPART              Sets the Participation Conditions                           .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRTRANSPCONNSTR           Sets the Transport Connections String                       .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_RRTYPE                    Sets the RE Search Request Type                             .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_SEARCHTERM                Sets Search Text                                            .
IF_REOR_RENTAL_REQUEST         I SET_XRR                       Sets the Text of RE Search Request                          .
IF_RERA_ACCRUAL_ENGINE         I INIT                          Initializes the Accrual Tool                                .
IF_RERA_ACCRUAL_ENGINE         I POST                          Posts Accruals/Deferrals                                    .
IF_RERA_ACCRUAL_ENGINE         I REVERSE                       Reverses Accruals                                           .
IF_RERA_ACCRUAL_POSTING        I GET_ACCRUAL_SUMMARY           Gets Accrual/Deferral Results                               .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I CLEAR_SELECTION               Deletes Selection Critera and Data                          .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_ACCT_STMNT_FROM_SEL       Gets Account Statement                                      .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_ACCT_STMNT_X_FROM_SEL     Gets Account Statement (Balance History)                    .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_CARRYFORWARD              Gets Current Balance Carryforward                           .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_ITEM_LIST_FROM_SEL        Gets List of Items                                          .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_ITEM_LIST_X_FROM_SEL      Gets List of Items                                          .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I GET_SUMMARY_FROM_SEL          Gets Summarized Values                                      .
IF_RERA_ACCT_SHEET             I SET_SELECTION                 Sets Selection Criteria and Selected Data                   .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_CN_ACCT_BY_PARTNER      Checks Open Item Account Number for a Contract and Partner  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_CURRENCY_CONVERSION     Checks Currency and Determines Exchange Rate and Date       .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_DOC_NUMBER              Checks Document Number                                      .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_HOUSEBKACC              Checks House Bank Account Key                               .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_HOUSEBKID               Checks House Bank Key                                       .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_OIACCOUNT               Checks Open Item Account Number                             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CHECK_TAXCODE_FOR_ACCOUNT     Checks If Tax Code Agrees with G/L Account                  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CLOSE_POSTING_CHANNEL         Closes the Posting Channel for a Posting Process            .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CONVERT_DOCITEMID             Converts FI Document Number to RE Internal Name             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I CREATE_DOC_FOR_EXT_ADVPAYMENT Generates RE Line Items from FI Down Payments(AP Legacy Data.
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I DECONVERT_DOCITEMID           Converts RE Internal Name to FI Document Number             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I DISPLAY_CASHFLOW_LIST         Display of Cash Flow List (Periodic Posting)                .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I DISPLAY_DOCUMENT              Document Display                                            .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I DISPLAY_DOCUMENT_LIST         Display of a Document List                                  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_ACC_DOC_DETAIL_LIST       Gets Detail Data of Accounting Documents                    .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_BUS_AREA                  Supplies Name of Business Area                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_CN_ACCTTYPE_BY_PARTNERROLEGets Open Item Account Type for a Partner Role              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_CN_ACCT_BY_PARTNER        Gets Open Item Account Number for a Contract and Partner    .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_CN_ACCT_MASTERDATA        Gets Master Data for Open Item Account Number               .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_CONTROLLING_AREA          Supplies Controlling Area of Company Code                   .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_COSTOBJECT                Supplies Name of a Cost Object                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_DOCUMENT_IDENT            Supplies Name of Document                                   .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_DOC_TYPE                  Gets Name of Document Type                                  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_DUNNING_AREA              Supplies Name of Dunning Area                               .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_DUNNING_BLOCK             Supplies Name of Dunning Block                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_FISCAL_PERIOD             Supplies Fiscal Period for Posting Date                     .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_FISCAL_PERIOD_DATES       Supplies Start and End Date of Fiscal Period                .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_FISCAL_YEAR_PERIODS       Gets Number of Posting Periods                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_GLACCOUNT                 Gets Account Number                                         .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_GLACCOUNT_LIST_BY_SCK     Supplies the RE Account Symbol for a Service Charge Key     .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_GLACCT_BY_BUKRS           Gets Name of G/L Account                                    .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_LINEITEM                  Supplies Line Item                                          .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_LOGSYSTEM                 Gets the Logical System                                     .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_MINOR_AMOUNT_LIMIT        Gets the Trivial Amount Limits                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_NOT_PAYABLE_ITEMS         Supplies Items Still to Be Paid                             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_PAYMENT_BLOCK             Supplies Name of Payment Block                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_PAYMENT_METHOD            Supplies Name of Payment Method                             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_PAYMENT_TERM              Supplies Name of Conditions of Payment                      .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_PROFITCENTER              Supplies Name of Profit Center                              .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_REFDOCID_BY_DOCITEMID     Gets Reference No. for External Encoding for Document Item  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_RE_DOC_FROM_EXT_DOC       Gets RE Document for External Document Number               .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I GET_TOTALS                    Supplies Total Costs                                        .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I HAS_ACCOUNTING_DOC            Have Postings Been Made to Business Object                  .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I INIT_BY_ACCSYSTEM             Initializes Object using ID of FI System                    .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I IS_BUS_AREA_BALANCE_ACTIVE    Is Business Area Balance Sheet Active?                      .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I IS_COST_OF_SALES_ACTIVE       Is Cost of Sales Accounting Active?                         .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I IS_PRCTR_ACCOUNTING_ACTIVE    Is Profit Center Accounting Active?                         .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I IS_PRCTR_ACCOUNTING_OBLIGATORYIs Profit Center Mandatory?                                 .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I OPEN_POSTING_CHANNEL          Opens the Posting Channel for a Posting Process             .
IF_RERA_ACC_SYSTEM             I SET_DOC_SPLIT_INFO            Sets Split Info for Posting Records (New Document Header)   .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Structure                                           .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I DELETE_DETAIL_BY_ACROBJGUID   Deletes Structure                                           .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT                          Initializes Manager                                         .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PROCESSGUID           Initializes Manager With Process GUID                       .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I INSERT_DETAIL                 Inserts Structure                                           .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I SET_STATUS_BY_ACROBJGUID      Sets Status                                                 .
IF_RERA_ACR_ITEM_MNGR          I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Structure                                           .
IF_RERA_ACR_PARAM              I INIT_BY_ACR_POSTING           Initialize Through Accrual Process                          .
IF_RERA_ACR_PARAM              I SET_PROCESSID                 Initialize Through Accrual Process Reversal                 .
IF_RERA_ACR_PARAM              I SET_PROCESSMODE               Initialize Through Accrual Process Reversal                 .
IF_RERA_ACR_REVERSAL_PARAM     I INIT_BY_REVERSAL              Initialize Through Accrual Process Reversal                 .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_BOOKING         I CLEAR_DOCS                    Clear                                                       .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_BOOKING         I CREATE_AND_PREPARE_DOCS       Create and Prepare Documents                                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_BOOKING         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_BOOKING         I POST_DOCS                     Update and Clear                                            .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_BOOKING         I REVERSAL                      Delete Documents                                            .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_ADD_OBJNR                 Supplies Object Number of Additional Account Assignment     .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR         Gets the Manager for Split Advance Payments [Abstract]      .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_AMOUNT_BY_CONTRACT        Supplies Amounts for Contract                               .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_AMOUNT_BY_OBJ             Supplies Amounts for an Object                              .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_CASHFLOW_MNGR             Supplies Cash Flow Manager                                  .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL_OBJ_X              Supplies Object Cash Flow Item for Key                      .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_FIRSTPOSTING              Gets Date of First Posting                                  .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_LIST_PAY_X                Supplies All Entries for Payment-Related Cash Flow          .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_PERIOD                    Supplies Period in Which Cash Flow Is Read                  .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_PREVIOUS_RESULTS          Supplies Results Of A Previous Calculation                  .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_RELEVANT_CONDITIONS       Supplies Respective Conditions                              .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_SETTLPERIOD               Supplies Settlement Period                                  .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_USED_CONDITIONS           Supplies Conditions of Contract for Settling                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I GET_VALIDFROM                 Gets Start Date of Contract                                 .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I HANDLE_NO_CFENTRY_FOUND       No cash flow entry found; next activity?                    .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I HAS_SPEC_GL_INDICATOR         Has Special G/L Indicator                                   .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I IS_ADVPAY_BOOKASREVENUE       AP Posted as Revenue                                        .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I IS_PAYED                      Was Item Cleared?                                           .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_CASHFLOW_MNGR   I IS_SIMMODE_ACTIVE             Determination Takes Place in Simulation Mode                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_EXT_MNGR        I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_EXT_MNGR        I GET_LIST_BY_CONDDETAIL        Gets All Entries for Condition and Period                   .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_EXT_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_EXT_MNGR        I SET_LIST                      Changes All Entries                                         .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I ADD_SPLIT                     Totals the Split Advance Payments                           .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I CREATE_AND_PREPARE_DOCS       Create and Prepare Documents                                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I DO_SPLIT                      Splits Cash Flow Record, When Necessary                     .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I GET_DOC                       Gets the Documents                                          .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I GET_REFDOC_LIST               Gets All Document References                                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I POST_DOCS                     Update                                                      .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I REVERSAL                      Delete Documents                                            .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_SPLIT_MNGR      I SET_LIST                      Changes All Entries                                         .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_TAX_MNGR        I GET_TAX_CHANGES               Gets Changes of Taxes (Posting Term/TSP Code)               .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_TAX_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initialization via Settlement                               .
IF_RERA_ADVPAY_TAX_MNGR        I ZIP_ADVPAYMENT                Summary of Individual Advance Payments Depending on MWSKZ   .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I CHANGE_OBJGUID                Changes Object GUID                                         .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET                           Supplies Advance Payments                                   .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_BOOKING_MNGR              Posting Manager                                             .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_CASHFLOW_MNGR             Cash Flow Manager                                           .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Gets All Advance Payments Determined Up to Now              .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_LIST_BY_OBJGUID           Gets All Advance Payments for Object Determined Up to Now   .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_MAINPARTNER4PERIOD        Supplies Main Partner within a Period                       .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I GET_TAX_MNGR                  Control Manager                                             .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I IS_STORABLE                   Checks If Saving Is Allowed                                 .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I LOAD_ENTRIES                  Load data                                                   .
IF_RERA_APAYMENT_MNGR          I REVERSAL                      Delete Documents Stored with STORE                          .
IF_RERA_COSTS_MNGR             I GET_COSTS                     Supplies Costs that Were Posted to this Object [Abstract]   .
IF_RERA_COSTS_MNGR             I HAS_DOC                       Have Postings Been Made to Object                           .
IF_RERA_COSTS_MNGR             I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I CHECK_DELETION_IND_ALLOWED    Checks Whether Deletion Indicator Can Be Set                .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I CHECK_HEADER                  Checks RE Document Header                                   .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I CHECK_ITEMS                   Checks RE Document Line Items                               .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_CURR_DUNN_DATA_BY_ITEMNO  Supplies Current Dunning Data for Line Item                 .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic and Additional Data           .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_IDENT                     Supplies Document Identification                            .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I GET_LIST                      Supplies Document Items                                     .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I INIT_BY_DATA                  "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I POST                          Posts Document                                              .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I POST_RE                       Posts RE Document                                           .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I REVERSE                       Reverses Document                                           .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I SET_CLEARING_STATUS           Sets Clearing Status                                        .
IF_RERA_DOC                    I SET_DELETION_IND              Sets Deletion Indicator                                     .
IF_RERA_DOC_GENERATOR          I INIT                          Initializes Document Generator                              .
IF_RERA_DOC_GENERATOR          I PERFORM                       Generates                                                   .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I CLEAR                         Clears Documents Items                                      .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I GET_AMOUNT_FOR_ADVPAY         Returns Amounts for Advanced Payment Transfer (SCS)         .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I GET_LIST                      Supplies List                                               .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_CLEARNGPROCESSID      Initializes Document Manager by ProcessID of Clearing       .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_CONDTYPE              Initializes Line Item Manager by Condition Type             .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_PARTNER               Initializes Line Item Manager by Partner Number             .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I INIT_BY_REFGUID               Initializes Line Item Manager by Reference GUID             .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I IS_PAYED                      Was Item Paid                                               .
IF_RERA_DOC_ITEM_MNGR          I UNDO_CLEARING                 Reverses Clearing                                           .
IF_RERA_DOC_MNGR               I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Generated Documents                      .
IF_RERA_DOC_MNGR               I GET_LIST                      Gets List of RE Documents                                   .
IF_RERA_DOC_MNGR               I INIT                          Initializes Documenten Manager                              .
IF_RERA_DOC_MNGR               I POST                          Posts the Document                                          .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_COMMITMENTITEM          Checks Commitment Item                                      .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_FUNCTIONALAREA          Checks Functional Area                                      .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_FUND                    Checks Fund                                                 .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_FUNDSCENTER             Checks Funds Center                                         .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_GRANT                   Checks Grant                                                .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I CHECK_MEASURE                 Checks Program in Funds Management                          .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_ACTIVE_FM_DIMENSIONS      Active Funds Management Components                          .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_COMMITMENTITEM_IDENT      Gets Name of Commitment Item                                .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_FUNCTIONALAREA_IDENT      Supplies Name of Functional Area                            .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_FUNDSCENTER_IDENT         Supplies Name of Funds Center                               .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_FUND_IDENT                Supplies Name of Fund                                       .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_GRANT_IDENT               Supplies Name of Grant                                      .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I GET_MEASURE_IDENT             Gets Name of Program in Funds Management                    .
IF_RERA_FUNDS_MANAGEMENT       I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RERA_HAS_APAYMENT           I GET_APAYMENT_MNGR             Supplies Advance Payment Manager                            .
IF_RERA_HAS_APAYMENT           I GET_LEGACY_DATA_MNGR          Gets AP Legacy Data Transfer Manager                        .
IF_RERA_HAS_COSTS              I GET_COSTS_MNGR                Supplies Cost Manager                                       .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I GET_CONTRACT_LIST             Gets the Contracts That the Invoice Refers To               .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Invoice Header and Additional Fields                   .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I GET_LIST                      Gets Invoice Items                                          .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Invoice Items and Additional Fields                    .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I INIT                          "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I INIT_BY_DATA                  "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RERA_INVOICE                I REQUERY                       Reads Invoice Data Again from Database                      .
IF_RERA_INVOICE_CREATION_PARAM I GET_DEFAULT_OPTIONS           Gets the Default Options                                    .
IF_RERA_INVOICE_CREATION_PARAM I SET_OBJECT_LIST               Changes the List of Contracts to Be Considered              .
IF_RERA_INVOICE_CREATION_PARAM I SET_OPTIONS                   Changes the Options                                         .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT                          Initializes Posting Module                                  .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_DOCGUID               Initializes by List of RE Document GUIDs                    .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_OBJNR                 Initialized by Process ID                                   .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_PROCESS               Initializes by Process                                      .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_PROCESSID             Initialized by Process ID                                   .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_REFERENCEDOCGUID      Initializes by List of Reference GUIDs                      .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I INIT_BY_REV_PARAM             Initializes by Reversal Parameters                          .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I POST                          Create documents                                            .
IF_RERA_POSTING_ENGINE         I REVERSE                       Reverse Documents                                           .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM          I INIT                          Initialize Parameters                                       .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_BALANCE                 Checks Balance of Line Items                                .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_BASE_DATA               Checks Basic Data                                           .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Checks Document Header Data                                 .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Checks Line Item Data                                       .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_SINGLE_HEADER           Checks Single Document Header                               .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_SINGLE_ITEM             Checks Single Line Item                                     .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I CHECK_WT_FOR_SINGLE_ITEM      Checks Withholding Tax Data for Single Line Item            .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I COMPLETE_BASE_DATA            Enhances Basic Data                                         .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I COMPLETE_HEADER_DATA          Enhances Document Header Data                               .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I COMPLETE_ITEM_DATA            Enhances Line Item Data                                     .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I COMPLETE_SINGLE_HEADER        Enhances Single Document Header                             .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I COMPLETE_SINGLE_ITEM          Enhances Single Line Item                                   .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I GENERATE_DISTRIBUTION_DATA    Generates Distribution Items                                .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I GENERATE_SINGLE_DISTRIBUTION  Generates Distribution Items for Individual Item            .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I GET_ACCTASS_PROPOSAL          Gets Proposal for Account Assignment                        .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I GET_OPACT_DATA                Gets Attribute of Posting Activity                          .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I INIT_BY_DOC_DATA              Initialize Using Existing Documents                         .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I INIT_BY_POSTING_RECORD        Initialize Using Posting Record                             .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I PREDEFINE_BASE_DATA           Defaults Basic Data from Customizing                        .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I PREDEFINE_HEADER_DATA         Defaults Document Header Data from Customizing              .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I PREDEFINE_ITEM_DATA           Defaults Line Item Data from Customizing                    .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REOP     I SET_OPACT_DATA                Sets Attribute of Posting Activity                          .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REPP     I INIT                          Initialization for Periodic Posting                         .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REPP     I INIT_BY_CASHFLOW              Fill the Paramaters through Cash Flow Records               .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PARAM_REPP     I INIT_BY_CASHFLOW_MNGR         Fill the Parameters through Cash Flow Manager               .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PROCESS        I CHECK_AUTHORITY_BY_LIST       Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PROCESS        I GET_POSTING_SUMMARY           Supplies Results of Posting Process                         .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PROCESS        I INIT                          Initializes Periodic Posting                                .
IF_RERA_POSTING_PROCESS        I UPDATE_POSTING_SUMMARY        Updates Results of Posting Process                          .
IF_RERA_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST                      List of RE Documents                                        .
IF_RERA_PREPARE_RESULTS        I INIT                          Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RERA_REVERSAL_PARAM         I INIT                          Initializes Reversal Parameters of the Posting Process      .
IF_RERA_REVERSAL_PARAM         I INIT_BY_OBJNR                 Initializes Reversal Parameters By List of Object Numbers   .
IF_RERA_REVERSAL_PARAM         I INIT_BY_REFERENCEDOCGUID      Initializes Reversal of the Posting Process                 .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I CALCULATE_TAX                 Tax Calculation                                             .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I CALC_TAX_BY_TERMPY            Tax Calculation With Posting Term                           .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I CREATE_TAX_ITEMS_BY_ALL       Generates Summarized Tax Items                              .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I CREATE_TAX_ITEMS_BY_ITEM      Generates RE Document Tax Items from RE Document Items      .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I GET_RETAXCODE_BY_EXTAXCODE    Supplies RE Tax Type and Group for Ext. Sales Tax ID        .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I GET_TAXTYPE_LIST_BY_MWART     Gets List of RE Tax Types for MWART = V or A                .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I GET_TAX_CHANGINGINTERVAL      When Was Tax Changed for Tax Type and Tax Group             .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I GET_TXJCD                     Supplies Name of Tax Jurisdiction Code                      .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I GET_VAT_TYPE                  Supplies VAT Type for Tax Type and Tax Group                .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I INIT                          Initializes Object Using ID of Tax Calculation System       .
IF_RERA_TAX_ENGINE             I IS_TXJCD_ACTIVE               Is Tax Jurisdiction Code Active?                            .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Change List of Consumer Numbers                             .
IF_RESC_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR         I SET_LIST_X                    Change List of Consumer Numbers Dependent on Settlement Co. .
IF_RESC_AJ_METHOD_SCSE         I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_RESC_AJ_METHOD_SCSE         I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_RESC_AJ_METHOD_SCSE         I GET_SCSE_DETAIL_BY_METHREFGUIDGets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_RESC_BC_ADVPAY              I PREPARE_TRANSFER              Documents for Transfer of Credited AP on Objects            .
IF_RESC_BC_SUBSTEP             I CREATE_AND_PREPARE_DOCS       Create and Prepare Documents                                .
IF_RESC_BC_SUBSTEP             I POST_DOCS                     Update Documents                                            .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_BALANCE_ZERO            Checks If Costs Are Zero                                    .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_DELETE_POSSIBLE         Checks If Deleting Cost Collector Is Possible               .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_DEL_FLAG_SET_POSSIBLE   Checks If Setting Deletion Flag on Cost Collector Possible  .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_DPERBEG                 Checks Start of a Settlement Period                         .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_SEMPSL                  Checks the Settlement Unit                                  .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_SNKSL                   Checks the Service Charge Key                               .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_STATUS                  Checks if status object dependent on transaction            .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Valid Business Entity                                .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I INIT_BY_PARENT                "Only For Factory Methods"                                  .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I IS_BOOKED                     Was Already Posted?                                         .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I IS_SETTLED                    Is Period Already Settled                                   .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS                    Sets 'transferred' status                                   .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS_LOCKED             Status: Locked                                              .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS_RELEASED           Status: Released                                            .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS_SEREVERSED         SCS Status Was Reversed                                     .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS_SETTLED            Status - Settled                                            .
IF_RESC_COSTCOLLECTOR          I SET_STATUS_UNLOCKED           Status - Unlocked                                           .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletion of Costs - Single Record                           .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Gets All Costs                                              .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initialization Using Superordinate BO                       .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I INSERT_DETAIL                 Setting of Costs - Single Record                            .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Setting of Costs                                            .
IF_RESC_COSTS_EXT_MNGR         I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changing of Costs - Single Record                           .
IF_RESC_DATA_METER             I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets the Parameters                                         .
IF_RESC_DATA_SUSESTATUS        I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets the Parameters                                         .
IF_RESC_D_TAPE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_LIST               Supplies Details for Object (and Time Period)               .
IF_RESC_D_TAPE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Details of an Entry                                .
IF_RESC_D_TAPE_MNGR            I GET_OVERVIEW_LIST             Supplies Overview of All Objects Involved                   .
IF_RESC_D_TAPE_MNGR            I REVERSAL                      Delete Data                                                 .
IF_RESC_D_TAPE_MNGR            I SET_DETAIL_LIST               Save Costs                                                  .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_EXBASERATE_MNGR        I SET_LIST                      Entries Are Placed in Table                                 .
IF_RESC_FUTURE_PARTICIP_GROUP  I INIT_BY_SETTLEMENT            Initialization Due to a Settlement                          .
IF_RESC_HAS_ACCFIRMNR          I GET_ACCFIRMNR_MNGR            Supplies Settlement Manager for External Settlement         .
IF_RESC_HAS_ADDRESS            I GET_ADDRESS                   Supplies the Address                                        .
IF_RESC_HAS_ADDRESS            I GET_ADDRESS_X                 Supplies Address Assignment with Address for Object         .
IF_RESC_HAS_MEAS               I GET_MEASVALUE_WITH_RANGE      Delivers All Measurements for Key Date (One or All)         .
IF_RESC_HAS_METER              I GET_METER_IMPLSUBTYPE         Gets the Implementation Name                                .
IF_RESC_HAS_METER              I GET_METER_MNGR                Supplies Meter Manager                                      .
IF_RESC_HAS_OBJECT_LIST        I GET_OBJ_LIST_MNGR             Delivers Object List Manager                                .
IF_RESC_HAS_OBJECT_LIST        I GET_TYPE_OF_OBJLIST           Delivers Object List Category                               .
IF_RESC_HAS_SCO_GROUP          I GET_SOGRP_MNGR                Delivers Object List Manager                                .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I CREATE_AND_PREPARE_DOCS       Create and Prepare Documents                                .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I DO_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT            Perform Input Tax Adjustment                                .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I GET_LIST                      Gets the Lists of Input Tax Adjustments                     .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I INIT_BY_OBJECT                Initialization                                              .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I LOAD_ENTRIES                  Load Data When Step Is Called Again                         .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I POST_DOCS                     Update and Clear                                            .
IF_RESC_ITAX_ADJUSTMENT        I REVERSAL                      Undo Settlement Step                                        .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_CONSUMPTION               Gets the Consumption                                        .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_CONSUM_HISTORY            Gets Consumption in a Time Period                           .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_FIRST_AND_LAST            First and Last Measurement Document in Period               .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_LAST                      Last Entered Measurement Document                           .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Gets the Measurement Documents                              .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_PERIOD            Gets the Measurement Documents for a Period                 .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RESC_MEASDOC_MNGR           I SET_LIST                      Sets the Measurement Documents                              .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I CHECK_MEASUREM_POINT          Checks If Measuring Points Exist                            .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I CHECK_MELNR                   Checks Number of Entry List                                 .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I CHECK_MELTX                   Checks Description of Entry List                            .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I CHECK_NAMEL                   Checks Name of Entry List                                   .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I GET_LIST                      Gets Measuring Points for Entry List                        .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I SET_LIST                      Changes Measuring Points for Entry List                     .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I SET_MELNR                     Changes Number of Entry List                                .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I SET_MELTX                     Changes Description of Entry List                           .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I SET_NAMEL                     Changes Name of Entry List                                  .
IF_RESC_MEAS_ENTRY_LIST        I SORT_BY_OBJID                 Sorting of Entry List                                       .
IF_RESC_MEAS_MNGR              I CALC_APPORTVALUE              Calculates Reference Factor                                 .
IF_RESC_MEAS_MNGR              I GET_VALUE_WITH_RANGE          Delivers All Measurements for Key Date (One or All)         .
IF_RESC_MEAS_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Measurement Manager via Superordinate Object    .
IF_RESC_MEAS_MNGR              I IS_MEAS_TIMESHARED            Is Measurement Type Time-Dependent                          .
IF_RESC_MEAS_MNGR_REF          I INIT_BY_REFERENCE             Initializes Via Reference                                   .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes a Measuring Point                                   .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_CONSUMPTION               Determine Consumption                                       .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_CONSUMPTION_BALANCE       Determine Consumption Remainder                             .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_CONSUM_LIST_X             Gets List of All Meas. Points + Consumption + Addit. Fields .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_LIST                      Gets List of All Measuring Points                           .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_LIST_X                    Gets List of All Measuring Points with Addit. Fields        .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_MEASDOC_MNGR              Gets the Measurement Documents Manager                      .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_DETAIL              Gets the Details for a Measuring Point                      .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_DETAIL_X            Gets the Details for a Measuring Point + Addit. Fields      .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_LIST                Gets the Details for a Measuring Point + Assigned Objects   .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_LIST_BY_CHARACT     Gets All Measuring Points for Characteristic                .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_LIST_BY_MEAS        Gets All Measuring Points for Measurement Type              .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_POINT_LIST_X              Gets List of All Measuring Points + Addit. Fields           .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I GET_SUBOBJ_LIST               Gets All Objects Assigned to a Meter                        .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds New Measuring Point                                    .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I REFRESH                       Reload Data                                                 .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I SET_POINT_LIST                Sets the List of All Measuring Points                       .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I SET_SUBOBJ_LIST               Sets the Objects Assigned to a Meter                        .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I SUBOBJ_ALLOWED                Are Subobjects Allowed at All                               .
IF_RESC_METER_MNGR             I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Updates Measuring Point                                     .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I CHECK_SUBOBJ                  Checks the Subordinate Object                               .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I GET_ALLOWED_OBJTYPE           Gets Allowed Object Types                                   .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_DATE          Gets Apportionment Rule for a Date                          .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Gets Subordinate SUs                                        .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I GET_LIST_BY_VALIDFROM         Gets Subordinate SUs Using Assignment Date                  .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I GET_LIST_X_BY_VALIDFROM       Gets Subordinate SUs and Additional Fields                  .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I SET_DETAIL_BY_VALIDFROM       Changes Apportionment Rule for a Date                       .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I SET_DETAIL_X_BY_VALIDFROM     Changes Apportionment Rule for a Date                       .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I SET_LIST                      Changes Subordinate SUs                                     .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I SET_LIST_WITH_VALIDFROM       Changes Subordinate SUs Using Assignment Date               .
IF_RESC_MSU_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR     I SET_LIST_X_WITH_VALIDFROM     Changes Subordinate SUs Using Date (Without INTRENO)        .
IF_RESC_OBJECT_LIST_MNGR       I GET_DETAILED_LIST             Gets Detailed List                                          .
IF_RESC_OBJECT_LIST_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Gets List of All Assigned Objects                           .
IF_RESC_OBJECT_LIST_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Object via Higher-Level Object                  .
IF_RESC_OBJ_LIST_FUTURE        I RESET_BUFFER                  Deletes All Entries in Table Buffer                         .
IF_RESC_OBJ_LIST_FUTURE        I UPLOAD                        Store Data in Internal Table                                .
IF_RESC_OBJ_LIST_MNGR_SETTL    I RESET_BUFFER                  Deletes All Entries in Table Buffer                         .
IF_RESC_OBJ_LIST_MNGR_SETTL    I UPLOAD                        Store Data in Internal Table                                .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_ALLOWED_OBJTYPE           Gets Allowed Object Types                                   .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_BUSOBJ_BY_IDENT_KEY       Supplies Business Object via Object ID                      .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_BUSOBJ_BY_INTRENO         Gets Business Object via INTRENO                            .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_LIST_X                    Gets All Entries with Additional Information                .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I GET_OBJ_REL_LIST              Gets All Assigned Rental Objects                            .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I SET_LIST                      Changes All Entries                                         .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR           I SET_LIST_BASIC                Changes All Entries (Basic Form)                            .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR_ROPG      I GET_SU4RO                     Gets the SUs for a Rental Object                            .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR_SUCO      I SET_RHYTHM_LIST               Changes Assigned Frequencies                                .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR_SUCO      I SET_TENANCYLAW                Changes Tenancy Law                                         .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR_SUCO      I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Start of Validity of a Settlement Unit              .
IF_RESC_OBJ_REL_MNGR_SUPG      I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Start of Validity of a Settlement Unit              .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_PGID                    Checks Group of ROs That Participate in a Settlement        .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Valid Business Entity                                .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Valid-From Date of Key of Participating Objects      .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks Valid-To Date of Key of Participating Objects        .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I CHECK_XPG                     Checks Name of Participating Rental Units                   .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_INVOLVED_BE               Gets Participating Business Entities                        .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_OBJ_REL_MNGR              Gets the Object Assignment Manager                          .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_PG_PARENTS                Gets the Superordinate SUs and/or Participation Groups      .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_SETTLUNITS                Gets the Settlement Units                                   .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Valid Business Entity                              .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_PGID                      Changes Group of ROs That Participate in a Settlement       .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_SWENR                     Changes Valid Business Entity                               .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Valid-From Date of Key of Participating Objects     .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_VALIDTO                   Changes Valid-To Date of Key of Participating Objects       .
IF_RESC_PARTICIP_GROUP         I SET_XPG                       Changes Name of Participating RUs                           .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_CNROHIERARCHY             Contract/Object Hierarchy                                   .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_CREDIT_RECEIVABLE         Credit/Receivables                                          .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_APPORTIONMENT        Distribution Overview                                       .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_CNRO2SU              Total Costs and Measurement Amounts for Contract and RO     .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_COSTS                Posted Costs per Object                                     .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_DOCS                 Gets the Documents That Were Read from Fin. Accounting      .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_MSU2OBJ              Master Settlement Unit to Settlement Unit                   .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_SCK_AND_OBJ          Service Charge Key and Rental Object                        .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_SU2CN                Distribution Settlement Unit to Usage View                  .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_LIST_SU2RO                Distribution Settlement Unit to Rental Object               .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_MEASUREMENT               Measurement                                                 .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_POSSIBLE_REPORTS          Delivers Possible Reports                                   .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_POSTING_LOG               Displays Posting Log                                        .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_RESULTS_FOR               Supplies Results for a Given Object                         .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_RESULTS_MEAS_DETAIL       Supplies Individual Changes to Measurement Amounts          .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_RESULT_PER_OBJECT         Supplies List per Contract/RO via SU (per Condition Type)   .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_SETTL_HIERARCHY           Settlement Hierarchy                                        .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_TAX_DISTRIBUTION          Gets Input Tax Adjustments Within Service Charge Settlement .
IF_RESC_PREPARE_RESULTS        I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Using Superordinate Object                      .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I CALC4RENTPERIOD               Calculate Receivables                                       .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I CALC4SINGLE_CONDTYPE          Calculates Receivable per Condition Type [Abstract]         .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I INIT_BY_TAXCALC               Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I IS_VALID                      Checks Amounts =" If Receivable " 0 then Insert [Abstract]  .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I SUM_ADVPAYMENT                Totals Advance Payments per Flow Type [Final]               .
IF_RESC_RECEIVABLE_CALC_ENGINE I SUM_DISTRIBUTION              Totals SU Results [Abstract]                                .
IF_RESC_SCO_GROUP_MNGR         I COMPARE                       Compares Two Partipation Groups                             .
IF_RESC_SCO_GROUP_MNGR         I GET_INVOLVED_BE               Delivers Relevant Business Entities                         .
IF_RESC_SCO_GROUP_MNGR         I GET_PARTICIP_GROUPS           Delivers Table with Participation Group and Period          .
IF_RESC_SCO_GROUP_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Instance Via Basic Data Structure               .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Currency                                           .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_INTRENO                   Delivers Internal Real Estate Master Data Code              .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_MAINPARTNER4PERIOD        Supplies Main Partner within a Period                       .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_OBJNR                     Supplies Object Number                                      .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_OBJ_LIST                  Gets the Rental Objects for a Contract                      .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_PARENT                    Gets the Superordinate Object                               .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_PAYMENT_TERM_BY_KEYDATE   Supplies Posting Rule by Key Date                           .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_RECNEND                   Supplies Contract End Date                                  .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_RECNNR                    Supplies RE Contract Number                                 .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_RECNTYPE                  Supplies RE External Contract Type                          .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_SCCNPART_MNGR             Supplies Settlement Participation Generator                 .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_TERM_PAYMENT_MNGR         Supplies Payment Rule Manager (Terms)                       .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I IS_ACTIVE                     Is Contract Active                                          .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I IS_INTERN                     Asks If Internal Contract Is Involved                       .
IF_RESC_SCSCONTRACT            I IS_OCCUPYING                  Asks If Contract Is an Occupancy Contract                   .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.)                            .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Entries                                  .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I EXISTS                        Checks If Entry Exists (Y/N)                                .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GENERATE_SCPART               Generates Settlement Participation for all LO's of Object   .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_BUKRS                     Delivers Company Code                                       .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_CHARACT_MNGR              Supplies the Fixtures and Fittings Manager                  .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_CN4PERIOD                 Supplies Lease-Outs for Object Within Period                .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Currency                                           .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_INTRENO                   Delivers Internal Real Estate Master Data Code              .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Entries Incl. Additional Data                  .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_MAINPARTNER4PERIOD        Supplies Main Partner within a Period                       .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_OBJNR                     Supplies Object Number                                      .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_OBJ_REL_MNGR              Object Assignment                                           .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_PARENT                    Gets the Superordinate Object                               .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_PAYMENT_TERM_BY_KEYDATE   Supplies Posting Rule by Key Date                           .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_POOLSPACE                 Supplies Pooled Space                                       .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_RENTALSPACE               Supplies Rental Units for a Pooled Space                    .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_ROTYPE                    Supplies Rental Object Type                                 .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_SCCNPART_MNGR             Supplies Settlement Participation Generator                 .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_SMENR                     Supplies Number of Rental Object                            .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_SNUNR                     Supplies External Usage Type of Rental Obect                .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_SU4PERIOD                 Supplies All Settlement Units of a RO                       .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_SWENR                     Delivers Business Entity Number                             .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Standard Text                                      .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I GET_USAGE_TYPE_INT            Supplies Category of Usage Type (Internal)                  .
IF_RESC_SCSRENTAL_OBJECT       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I CHECK_AUTHORITY_BY_SO_BUKRS   Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I GET_LIST_EXECUTEABLE_STEPS    Supplies All Possible Executable Settlement Steps           .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I GET_LIST_POSSIBLE_STEPS       Supplies All Possible Settlement Steps                      .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I GET_LIST_REVERSEABLE_STEPS    Supplies All Possible Reversable Settlement Steps           .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I GET_NEXT_POSSIBLE_STEP        Supplies Next Possible Settlement Step                      .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement                                .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I IS_STEP_SELECTABLE            Is Settlement Step Selectable for Menu                      .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I REVERSAL_STEP                 Undo Up To One Settlement Step                              .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I RUN_MULTIPLE_STEPS            Execute Several Settlement Steps                            .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I RUN_SINGLE_STEP               Execute Settlement Step                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT             I STORE_IMMEDIATELY             Save Immediately?                                           .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I CHECK_PARAM_CUSTOMIZING       Checks Customizing Parameters                               .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_AJPROCESSGUID             Sets the Generic Key of the Adjustment Run                  .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_BLINEDATE                 Sets Baseline Date for Due Date Calculation                 .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_CHRG_PERCENT              Sets Percentage That Is Added to Result                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_CREDITDUEDATE             Sets Due Date for Credit Memos                              .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_DOCCOUNTER                Sets Document Counter to New Value                          .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_DOCDATE                   Sets Document Date for Documents                            .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_DTAPE_ACCESS              Sets Read Method for D-Tape                                 .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_DTAPE_NAME                Sets Name of D-Tape                                         .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_HEADERTXT                 Sets Document Header Text                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_KEYDATECOP                Sets the Key Date for the Current Occupancy Principle       .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_LAST_STEP                 Sets Last Performed Settlement Step                         .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_MEASKEYDATE               Sets Key Date for Determining Measurement                   .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_MLTAPE_ACCESS             Sets Storage Method for M/L-Tape                            .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_MLTAPE_NAME               Sets Name of M/L-Tape                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_MLTAPE_SORTBY             Sets the Algorithm for Output of the M/L-Tape               .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_ORPARAM                   Sets Necessary Parameters for Option Rate Determination     .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PARAMKEY                  Sets the Settlement Schema                                  .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PFROM                     Sets the Start of the Settlement Period                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PSTNGDATE                 Sets the Posting Date for the Documents                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PSTNGPERIOD               Setting of Posting Period                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PTO                       Sets the End of the Settlement Period                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_SANPNR                    Sets the Adjustment Method for Rent Adjustment              .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_SCSPARAMS                 Set SCS-Specific Parameters                                 .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_SETTLPERIOD               Which Period Is Being Settled                               .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_SPOOLNR                   Sets the Spool Number                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_TAXDATE                   Sets the Key Date for Tax Calculation                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_VERSION                   Sets the Plan Version                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_COSTOBJECT   I GET_CO_PARENT                 Determine Superordinate SUs                                 .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_MASTER       I GET_ASSIGN_SU_MNGR            Gets Settlement Unit Assignment Manager                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CAN_EXCHANGE                  Can Data Be Exchanged                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CHECK_DIRECT_COSTS_OBJLIST    Checks Direct Account Assignment for All Objects            .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CHECK_EXCHANGETYPE            Checks Type of Data Exchange                                .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CHECK_PERHEATING              Checks Percentage of Basic Costs for Heating                .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CHECK_PERHOTWATER             Checks Percentage of Basic Costs for Hot Water              .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I CHECK_SETTLADVPAY             Checks Indicator for Settlement by Settlement Company       .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I DISABLE_EXCHANGE              Prevents Data Exchange                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I ENABLE_EXCHANGE               Allows Data Exchange                                        .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I GET_ASSIGN_PG_MNGR            Gets Participation Group Assignment Manager                 .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I GET_EXBASERATE_MNGR           Gets Basic Component Assignment Manager                     .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I GET_RO_AND_CN                 Supplies Rental Objects and Lease-Outs for Period           .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I SET_EXCHANGETYPE              Changes the Type of Data Exchange                           .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I SET_PERHEATING                Changes Percentage of Basic Costs for Heating               .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I SET_PERHOTWATER               Changes Percentage of Basic Costs for Hot Water             .
IF_RESC_SETTLUNIT_NORMAL       I SET_SETTLADVPAY               Changes Indicator for Settlement by Settlement Company      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I DEL_EXCEPTION                 Deletes Exceptions                                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GENERATE_SCPART               Generates Settlement Participation per SU and RO            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GENERATE_SCPART_ALL           Generates Settlement Participation for All ROs of LO        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GENERATE_STANDARD_SCPART      Generates Settlement Participation (ohne LO Agreements)     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_CONDITIONS                Delivers Conditions for An Object and All Dependent Objects .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_CONDITIONS_X              Delivers Valid Conditions for a RO and SCK                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_LIST               Supplies Details for Object (and Time Period)               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Gets All Details                                            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_OBJ_LIST                  Gets the Rental Objects for Contract  [Abstract]            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_OVERVIEW_LIST             Supplies Overview of All Objects Involved                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_PART_DEFAULTS             Supplies Tenant Share and Maximum Costs                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_SCKPARTICIP               Supplies Saved Settlement Participation Exceptions          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I GET_STANDARD4NOCOND           Supplies Standard Settlement Participation If No Condition  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I IS_SCK_SETTLABLE              Is SCK Eligible for Settlement                              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I SET_DETAIL_LIST               New Exceptions are Created for a RO                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_CNPART_MNGR      I SET_LIST                      New Exceptions Are Set                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP             I GET_MESSAGES                  Delivers Messages On Step                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP             I GET_STATUS                    Returns Status of Settlement Step                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AF          I GET_EXIT                      Gets the BAdI                                               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AF          I GET_LIST                      Gets All Measurement Amounts                                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AJ          I GET_RESULT_BY_SUBOBJ          Gets the Results for Object and Subobject                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AP          I GET_AMOUNTS                   Supplies Amounts (for Entire Step)                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AP          I GET_APAYMENT_MNGR             Supplies Advance Payment Manager                            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AP          I GET_RENTPERIOD_LIST           Gets Rental Periods and the Required Conditions             .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_AP          I GET_TRGOBJNR                  COCP: Gets the OBJNR on Which the APs Are Posted            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_BC          I GET_EXIT_REF                  Returns the Instance of the User Exit (BAdI)                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_BC          I SET_CC_STATUS_RELEASED        Sets "Released" Status on Cost Collectors                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_BC          I SET_CC_STATUS_SETTLED         Sets "Setttled" Status on Cost Collectors                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_BC          I SET_DIST_STATUS               Sets Distribution Status for Input Tax Documents            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_CCR         I GET_ALL_RESULTS_BY_OBJ        Supplies Results for a Given Object                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_CCR         I GET_LIST                      Gets the List of Receivables                                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_ITAXADJUST_LIST           Return Table of All Input Tax Distributions                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_ITAXADJUST_MNGR           Gets the Input Tax Correction Manager                       .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_LIST_BY_OBJGUIDSRC        Gets All Entries for a Source Object                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_LIST_BY_OBJGUIDTRG        Gets All Entries for a Target Object                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_LIST_X_BY_OBJGUIDSRC      Gets All Entries for a Source Object                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_LIST_X_BY_OBJGUIDTRG      Gets All Entries for a Target Object                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_OBJITAXADJUST_LIST        Gets Table with Objects with Input Tax Distribution         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_DC          I GET_RESULT_PER_OBJECT         Supplies List per Contract/RO via SU (per Condition Type)   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_EDT         I DETERMINATE_STATUS            Set Status                                                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_EDT         I GET_DTAPE_MNGR                Gets Manager for Importing D-Tapes                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_EMLT        I GET_MLTAPE_MNGR               Gets Manager for Creating M/L-Tapes                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I GET_COST_LIST                 Gets List of All Costs                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I GET_DETAIL_BY_COSTGUID        Gets the Costs                                              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I GET_DOC_LIST                  Gets List of All Documents                                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I GET_LIST_BY_GUID              Supplies All Entries for an Object                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I GET_SUM_BY_OBJGUID            Supplies Total of Costs for an Object                       .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I SET_CC_STATUS_LOCKED          Sets "Locked" Status on the Cost Collectors                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_GC          I SET_CC_STATUS_UNLOCKED        Sets "Unlocked" Status on the Cost Collectors               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_AF    I SET_MEASKEYDATE               Sets Key Date for Determining Measurement                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_AJ    I GET_ADJUSTPARAM               Gets the Parameters for the Adjustment Process              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_AJ    I SET_ADJUSTPARAM               Sets the Parameters for the Adjustment Process              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_AJ    I SET_EXTERNAL                  Adjustment Is Created by Separate Program                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I HAS_CN_CREDIT                 Does Contract Have Credit Memo                              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I MARK_CN_AS_HAS_CREDIT         Indicates Contract "Has Credit Memo"                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_BLINEDATE                 Sets Baseline Date for Due Date Calculation                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_CREDITDUEDATE             Sets Due Date for Credit Memos                              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_DOCCOUNTER                Sets Document Counter to New Value                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_DOCDATE                   Sets Document Date for Documents                            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_HEADERTXT                 Sets Document Header Text                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_PSTNGDATE                 Sets the Posting Date for the Documents                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_PSTNGPERIOD               Setting of Posting Period                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_REVERSALPARAM             Transfers the Reversal Parameters                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_CP    I SET_EXTERNAL                  Correspondence Is Created by Separate Program               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_D     I SET_EXTERNAL                  D-Tape Is Imported by Separate Program                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_D     I SET_TAPE_PARAM                Set Paramaters for Tape                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_GC    I SET_VERSION                   Sets the Plan Version                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_ML    I SET_EXTERNAL                  M/L-Tape Is Created by Separate Program                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_ML    I SET_TAPE_PARAM                Set Paramaters for Tape                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_SH    I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization [Final]                                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_SH    I SET_SO                        Structure of All Necessary SU's via SELECT-OPTIONS          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_SH    I SET_SULIST                    Structure of All Necessary SU's via List of SU's            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I ANALYSE_EXCHANGE              Is Data Exchange Necessary and Which Data Is Needed         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I CHECKUP_SU_AND_SETTLTYPE      Checks If List of SU's Matches Settlement Type              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Values for an SU                                       .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Values for an SU + Additional Fields                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_LIST                      Gets All Values                                             .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_LIST_BY_OBJNR             Gets All Values for an Object Number                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_REAL_RENTPERIOD           Gets "Real" Entry for a Rental Period [Abstract]            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_REF_RENTPERIOD            Gets Referencing Entry  [Abstract]                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_RENTPERIOD_COPLIST        Gets the Periods to Which There Is No Reference [Abstract]  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_RENTPERIOD_LIST           Gets the Rental Periods                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_ROCN_LIST                 Gets All Rental Objects/Contracts                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_ROCN_LIST_BY_GUID         Gets All Rental Objects/Contracts for a Rental Period       .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I GET_SETTLPERIOD               Supplies Settlement Period                                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I HAS_CURROCCPRINCIPLE          Should Current Occupancy Principle Be Used for RO           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I HAS_SHAREOUTRULE              Does SU Have an Allocation Rule                             .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I INS_NEW_ROCN_ENTRY            Creates a New Rental View Entry                             .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I INS_ROCN                      Adds a New Rental Period  [Final]                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Values of an SU                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I SET_DETAIL_X                  Changes Values of an SU + Additional Fields                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I SET_LIST                      Changes All Values                                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_STEP_SH          I SET_MODIFY_FLAG               If an Independent Settlement Step Has Changed Data          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_BUKRS                   Checks Company Code                                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_HASCOSTOBJECT           Checks Indicator If SU Has Cost Objects                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_SEMPSL                  Checks Settlement Unit                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_SNKSL                   Checks Service Charge Key                                   .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_SWENR                   Checks Valid Business Entity                                .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_TENANCYLAW              Checks Tenancy Law                                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_VALIDFROM               Checks Start of Validity of Settlement Unit                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_VALIDTO                 Checks End of Validity of a Settlement Unit                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I CHECK_XSU                     Checks Name of Settlement Unit                              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR            Checks Cost Collector Assignment Manager                    .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_ASSIGN_CO_MNGR            Object Assignment                                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_BEGIN4SU                  When Was a Participation ID First Assigned                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_BUSINESS_AREA             Delivers Business Area                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_COSTS_EXT_MNGR            Gets the Manager for the Costs Not Posted in FI/CO          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_CURRENCY                  Supplies Currency                                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure with Basic Data                          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_DETAIL_OLD                Supplies Structure for Basic Data (Original DB Data)        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Basic Data and Additional Fields    .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_END4SU                    End of Settlement Unit                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_KEY                       Supplies Fields of the Business Key                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_MSU_LIST                  Determines Master Settlement Unit                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_NEXT_SETTL_PERIOD         Determination of First Period of SU That Is Not Settled     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_PERIOD4DATE               Determines Period in Which Date Occurs                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_PROFIT_CENTER             Supplies Profit Center                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_RHYTHM_MNGR               Gets Frequency Manager                                      .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_SESETTINGS_MNGR           Gets the Settings per Settlement Purpose                    .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_SETTLEMENT                Gets the Settlement                                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_SHAREOUT_MNGR             Gets Distribution Formula Manager                           .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_SU_CHILDREN               Determine Participating Settlement Units                    .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_SU_PARENT                 Determine Superordinate SUs                                 .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I GET_TERM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR  Supplies Organizational Assignment Manager (Terms)          .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I IS_SETTLED                    IS SU Already Settled for Period                            .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SETTLED_TO                    Calculated to                                               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_BUKRS                     Changes Company Code                                        .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_HASCOSTOBJECT             Changes Indicator If SU Has Cost Objects                    .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_SEMPSL                    Changes Settlement Unit                                     .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_SNKSL                     Changes Service Charge Key                                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_SWENR                     Changes Valid Business Entity                               .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_TENANCYLAW                Changes Tenancy Law                                         .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Start of Validity of a Settlement Unit              .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_VALIDTO                   Changes End of Validity of Settlement Unit                  .
IF_RESC_SETTL_UNIT             I SET_XSU                       Changes Name of Settlement Unit                             .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I DO_TRANSACTION                Executes Transaction                                        .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GENERATE_COSTCOLLECTOR        Generates a New Cost Collector                              .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_COSTCOLLECTOR             Gets Cost Collector for Period                              .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_COSTCOLLECTOR_BY_KEYDATE  Gets Cost Collector for a Key Date                          .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure for Primary Key                          .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Additional Information for a Cost Collector            .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_INVALID_CC                Supplies Invalid Cost Collectors                            .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_LASTSETTLED               Supplies Cost Collector Last Settled                        .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Supplies the Cost Collectors                                .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies the Cost Collectors and Additional Fields          .
IF_RESC_SU_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR      I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_ASSIGN_CC_MNGR            Checks Cost Collector Assignment Manager                    .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_DEFAULT                   Gets Default Settlement Variant                             .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Supplies First Entry to a Date                              .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_FIRST                     First Assigned Frequency                                    .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_LIST                      Gets the Assigned Frequencies                               .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_LIST_X                    Gets the Assigned Frequencies and Additional Fields         .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_PERIOD4DATE               Determines Period in Which Date Occurs                      .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_PERIOD_LIST               Gets All Settlement Periods                                 .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I GET_SHAREOUT_MNGR             Gets Distribution Formula Manager                           .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I SET_LIST                      Changes Assigned Frequencies                                .
IF_RESC_SU_RHYTHM_MNGR         I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Start of Validity of a Settlement Unit              .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL                    Gets the Settings                                           .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Gets the Settings for a Key Date                            .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I GET_LIST                      Gets All Settings                                           .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I SET_DETAIL                    Changes the Settings                                        .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I SET_LIST                      Changes All Settings                                        .
IF_RESC_SU_SESETTINGS_MNGR     I SET_SNKSL                     Changes Service Charge Key                                  .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_DEFAULT                   Gets Default Allocation Rules                               .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Supplies First Entry to a Date                              .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_DATE          Supplies First Entry to a Date                              .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Gets the Assigned Allocation Rules                          .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_LIST_BY_DATE              Gets Assigned Allocation Rules by Any Date                  .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_LIST_BY_VALIDFROM         Gets Assigned Allocation Rules by Assignment Date           .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X_BY_VALIDFROM       Gets Assigned Allocation Rules by Assignment Date           .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I HAS_SHAREOUTRULE              Has Allocation Rule [abstract]                              .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I HAS_SIMULATION_SHAREOUTRULE   Has Allocation Rule for the Simulation [Abstract]           .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I SET_LIST                      Changes the Assigned Allocation Rules                       .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I SET_LIST_WITH_VALIDFROM       Changes the Assigned Allocation Rules by Assignment Date    .
IF_RESC_SU_SHAREOUT_MNGR       I SET_VALIDFROM                 Changes Start of Validity of a Settlement Unit              .
IF_RESC_TAPE_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initializes Manager via Settlment Company                   .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM             I INIT_BY_TAPE_TYPE             Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM             I SET_OBJGUID_LIST              Sets List of Objects                                        .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM             I SET_TAPE_PARAM                Set Paramaters for Tape                                     .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM_A           I SET_ACCFIRM                   Transfer Settlement Company                                 .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM_D           I SET_PARENT                    Transfer Superordinate Object                               .
IF_RESC_TAPE_PARAM_ML          I SET_PARENT                    Transfer Superordinate Object                               .
IF_RESC_TAPE_READ_MNGR         I CHECK_STATUS                  Gets Status of Import                                       .
IF_RESC_TAPE_READ_MNGR         I CONVERT                       Converts External Format to Internal                        .
IF_RESC_TAPE_READ_MNGR         I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initializes Manager via Settlment Company                   .
IF_RESC_TAPE_READ_MNGR         I READING                       Reading of Tape                                             .
IF_RESC_TAPE_WRITE_MNGR        I CONVERT                       Converts RE Table to M/L Record                             .
IF_RESC_TAPE_WRITE_MNGR        I CREATE_DATA                   Build RE Data                                               .
IF_RESC_TAPE_WRITE_MNGR        I INIT_BY_PARAM                 Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESC_TAPE_WRITE_MNGR        I WRITE_TO_FILE                 Data Is Stored                                              .
IF_RESC_TAPE_WRITE_PARAM       I SET_TAPE_ATTR                 Sets Attributes for Tape to Be Created                      .
IF_RESR_BC_SUBSTEP             I PERFORM_SINGLE_SALESRULE      Execute a Single Sales Rule [Abstract]                      .
IF_RESR_CALC_METH              I CALC                          Calculates Sales-Based Rent                                 .
IF_RESR_CALC_METH              I GET_RESULT                    Calculates Results per Sales Rule                           .
IF_RESR_CALC_METH              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I DELETE_RESULT                 Deletes a Result                                            .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I GET_LIST                      Gets All Results                                            .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I GET_RESULT                    Gets the Results                                            .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I LOAD_BY_OBJGUID               Supplies for a Given Object ID                              .
IF_RESR_CALC_RESULT            I SET_RESULT                    Results in an Internal List                                 .
IF_RESR_HAS_SETTLPERIOD        I GET_RELATEDPERIODS            Gets All Consecutive Periods                                .
IF_RESR_HAS_SETTLPERIOD        I GET_RHYTHM_LIST               Gets the Assigned Frequencies                               .
IF_RESR_HAS_SETTLPERIOD        I GET_SETTLPERIOD_LIST          Gets the Settlement Periods                                 .
IF_RESR_HAS_SETTLPERIOD        I SET_RHYTHM_LIST               Changes Assigned Frequencies                                .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_CONDDETAIL                Gets the Assigned Condition Type                            .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Data for Entry                                         .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets the Data on a Specific Key Date                        .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_HEADER                    Gets Header Data of Sales Rule                              .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_HEADER_X                  Gets Header Data of Sales Rule and Additional Data          .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I GET_LIST                      Gets All Sales Rules and Periods                            .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Data for Entry                                      .
IF_RESR_IS_SB_RULE             I SET_HEADER                    Changes Header Data of Sales Rule                           .
IF_RESR_METHOD_SALE            I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_RESR_METHOD_SALE            I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Gets All Data for this Result                               .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets All Data for this Result                               .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Gets the Data                                               .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Data and Additional Fields                             .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I INIT_BY_LIST                  Initializes Instance via Instances of Sales-Based Settlmts  .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Data for this Result                                .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I SET_LIST                      Changes Data                                                .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I SET_OBJSTATUS                 Activates Change to this Result                             .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I SET_OBJSTATUS_ALL             Activates the Change                                        .
IF_RESR_MODIFYRESULT_MNGR      I SET_OBJSTATUS_LIST            Activates the Change to a List of Object GUIDs              .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I GET_CALCRULE_LIST             Gets Assigned Sales Rules                                   .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I GET_CALCRULE_LIST_X           Gets Assigned Sales Rules                                   .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Data for Entry Plus Additional Data                    .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I GET_REPORTRULE_LIST           Gets the Reporting Rule and Its Texts                       .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I GET_SBRULE_LIST               Gets the Sales Rules and Their Texts                        .
IF_RESR_MSB_RULE_MNGR          I SET_CALCRULE_LIST             Changes the Assigned Sales Rules                            .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_CALCRESULT                Gets the Results of Calculation                             .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_MESSAGES                  Gets All Messages                                           .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_OBJ_STATUS                Gets Object Status per Step                                 .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_POSSIBLE_REPORTS          Delivers Possible Reports                                   .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_POSTING_LOG               Displays Posting Log                                        .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_STATUS                    Gets the Status of All Settlements                          .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_STEP_MESSAGES             Gets the Messages for a Settlement Step                     .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I GET_STEP_STATUS               Gets the Status of All Settlement Steps                     .
IF_RESR_PREPARE_RESULTS        I INIT_BY_LIST                  Initializes Instance via Instances of Sales-Based Settlmts  .
IF_RESR_RECEIVABLE_CALC        I CALC                          Calculates Credit/Receivable                                .
IF_RESR_RECEIVABLE_CALC        I INIT_BY_TAXCALC               Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I CHECK_LIST                    Checks All Selected Entries                                 .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I GET_NEW_VERSION_FOR_REPORT    New Version Is Added for a Sales Report                     .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I GET_PARAM                     Gets the Paramters of the Sales Report                      .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I GET_RPRULE_DETAIL_BY_DATE     Gets the Data on a Specific Key Date                        .
IF_RESR_REPORTDATA             I SET_LIST                      Transfer of All Entries                                     .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I EDIT_SALESREPORT              Sales Report Is Changed                                     .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Gets All Sales Reports                                      .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I GET_LIST_OLD                  Gets All Old Sales Reports                                  .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I GET_NEW_VERSION_FOR_REPORT    New Version Is Added for a Sales Report                     .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I GET_REPORTDATA_BY_SO          Gets Data Manager via Selection Options                     .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I GET_TERMNO                    Gets All Reporting Rules                                    .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I IS_READONLY                   Is Sales Report Read-Only                                   .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MNGR            I REFRESH                       Frequency Was Changed in Reporting Rule                     .
IF_RESR_REPORT_MULTIPLE_MNGR   I INIT_BY_LIST                  Initializes Manager                                         .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Gets Data for Entry                                         .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets the Data on a Specific Key Date                        .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Data for Entry Plus Additional Data                    .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_INTERVAL_LIST             Gets Reporting Intervals                                    .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Gets All Reporting Rules and Periods                        .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_RHYTHM_DETAIL             Gets the Assigned Frequency                                 .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_RHYTHM_LIST               Gets the Assigned Frequencies                               .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I GET_SBRULE_LIST               Gets the Sales Rules and Their Texts                        .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I SET_DETAIL                    Changes Data for Entry                                      .
IF_RESR_REPORT_RULE_MNGR       I SET_RHYTHM_LIST               Changes Assigned Frequencies                                .
IF_RESR_RG_STATE_SRSE          I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Registration Entries                                   .
IF_RESR_RG_STATE_SRSE          I SET_PARAM_BC                  Transfer of Parameters for Posting Interface                .
IF_RESR_RG_STATE_SRSE          I SET_PARAM_PROCESS             Transfer of Parameters for Settlement Process               .
IF_RESR_RG_STATE_SRSE          I SET_PROCESSMODE               Simulation or Update Runs                                   .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_CALCRULE_LIST             Gets Assigned Reporting Rules                               .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_CALCRULE_LIST_X           Gets Assigned Reporting Rules and Additional Data           .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_CUMULATED_PERIOD          Gets Cumulative Period for a Settlement Period              .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_DEPCUMPERIODS             Gets All Consecutive Periods                                .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Data for Entry Plus Additional Data                    .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_MSBRULE_LIST              Gets Peak Sales Rules and Their Texts                       .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_REPORTRULE_LIST           Gets the Reporting Rule and Its Texts                       .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_SALESGRADING_LIST         Gets Assigned Sales Grading                                 .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I GET_SALESGRADING_TYPE         Gets Type of Sales Grading                                  .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I IS_LASTCUMPERIOD              Is Period Last Within a Cumulative Period                   .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I SET_CALCRULE_LIST             Changes Assigned Reporting Rules                            .
IF_RESR_SB_RULE_MNGR           I SET_SALESGRADING_LIST         Changes the Assigned Sales Grading                          .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I CALC_PART                     Calculates Sales-Based Rent for a Subrule  [abstract]       .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I CALC_SALESRENT                Calculates the Sales-Based Rent [abstract]                  .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I GET_CONDAMOUNT                Gets the Amount for a Condition Type                        .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I GET_NEXT_SETTLPERIOD          Determines First Period Not Settled                         .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I GET_NEXT_VERSION              Gets Next Version                                           .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I GET_PERIOD4DATE               Determines Period in Which Date Occurs                      .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I GET_PYTERMDETAIL              Gets Posting Term                                           .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object                .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I IS_SETTLED                    Was Sales Rule Already Settled for Period                   .
IF_RESR_SB_TERM_CALC           I SETTLED_TO                    Calculated to                                               .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I ENABLE_CORRECTION_MODE        Activates Correction Mode                                   .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I IS_CORRECTION_MODE            Settlement Currently in Correction Mode?                    .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_DOCCOUNTER                Sets Document Counter to New Value                          .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_NECESSARY_PARAM           Sets Parameters of Sales-Based Settlement                   .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_PARAMKEY                  Sets Parameters of Sales-Based Settlement                   .
IF_RESR_SETTLEMENT_PARAM       I SET_REASON                    Sets Reason for Correction Settlement                       .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP             I GET_LAST_SUCCSTEP             Determines Last Successful Step                             .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_GET         I ADD_SALESRULE                 Adds a New Sales Rule to Be Settled                         .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_GET         I CHANGE_SALESRULE              Change Sales Rule                                           .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_GET         I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization                                        .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_GET         I IS_SALESRULE_SELECTED         Was Sales Rule Selected                                     .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_CALC_RESULT               Gets Values from Original Calculation                       .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_DETAIL                    Gets All Data for this Result                               .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets All Data for this Result and Additional Fields         .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_LIST                      Gets the Data                                               .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_LIST_X                    Gets Data and Additional Fields                             .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_STEP_CALC                 Gets Settlement Step "Calculation"                          .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I GET_STEP_GET                  Gets Settlement Step "Determine LO"                         .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I SET_DETAIL                    Changes All Data for this Result                            .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I SET_LIST                      Changes Data                                                .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I SET_OBJSTATUS                 Activates Change to this Result                             .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I SET_OBJSTATUS_ALL             Activates the Change                                        .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_MODIFY      I SET_OBJSTATUS_LIST            Activates the Change to a List of Object GUIDs              .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_DOCCOUNTER                Sets Document Counter to New Value                          .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_PARAM                     Transfers the Parameters                                    .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_BC    I SET_REVERSALPARAM             Transfers the Reversal Parameters                           .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_CP    I SET_EXTERNAL                  Correspondence Is Created by Separate Program               .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_GET   I CLEAR_PARAM                   Release Memory                                              .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_GET   I SET_PARAM                     Sets the Parameters                                         .
IF_RESR_SETTL_STEP_PARAM_MODI  I SET_EXTERNAL                  Results Are Changed in a Separate Program                   .
IF_RETM_HAS_TERM               I GET_TERM_MNGR                 Supplies Clause Manager                                     .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Notice Term                                          .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Notice Term                                        .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Notice Term, Incl. Additional Data                 .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I GET_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR          Supplies Notice Procedure Manager                           .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I HAS_NOTICE_TERM               Is a Notice Procedure Defined?                              .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Notice Term                                         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_OBJ_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_OBJ_MNGR        I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_OBJ_MNGR        I GET_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR          Supplies Notice Procedure Manager                           .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I ADOPT_DATA_BY_OTHER           Adopts Data from Other Object [final]                       .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CALC_DATE                     Calculates Notice Date for Notice Procedure [final]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CALC_DATE_BY_RULE             Calculates Notice Date for Notice Rule [final]              .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CALC_DATE_LIST                Calculates Notice Date for Notice Procedure [final]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CALC_DATE_LIST_BY_RULE        Calculates Notice Date for Notice Rule [final]              .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Notice Rule Exists (Exc.) [final]                 .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CHECK_PROC_PARTY              Checks Party Giving Notice of Notice Rule                   .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CHECK_RULE                    Checks Definition of Notice Rule [final]                    .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I CHECK_RULETYPE                Checks If Notice Rule Agrees w/ Entered Rule Type [final]   .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Notice Rules in Notice Procedure [final] .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I COUNT_RULE_ITEMS              Supplies Number of Entries in Notice Procedurel [final]     .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I DELETE_ALL                    Deletes All Assigned Notice Rules [abstract]                .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Notice Rule (Basic Data and Definition)[abstract]   .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I EXISTS                        Checks If Notice Rule Exists (Y/N) [final]                  .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Basic Data of Notice Rule [final]                  .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Basic Data of Notice Rule + Addit. Data [final]    .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Assigned Notice Rules [final]                  .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Assigned Notice Rules + Addit. Data [final]    .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_PROC_HEADER_X             Supplies Properties of Notice Procedure [abstract]          .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_PROC_PARTY                Supplies Party Giving Notice in Notice Rule [final]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_PROC_TEXT_REF             Supplies Reference to Descript. of Notice Proced.[abstract] .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_RULETYPE                  Supplies Type of Notice Rule [final]                        .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_RULE_DR_ITEMS             Supplies Definition of Deadline Regulation(Deadlines)[final].
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_RULE_PR_ITEMS             Supplies Definition of Period Regul.(Notice Periods)[final] .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_SIM_DEFAULTS              Supplies Default Values for Simulation Parameters [final]   .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Text of Notice Rule [final]                        .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I HAS_PROC_TEXT_REF             Is There a Description of Notice Procedure? [Final]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_CUST_PROC             Initializes Manager for Standard Notice Procedure [abstract].
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_CUST_PROC_DATA        Initializes Manager for Notice Procedure Data [abstract]    .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_CUST_RULE             Initializes Manager for Standard Notice Rule [abstract]     .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_CUST_RULE_DR_DATA     Initializes Manager for Notice Rule Data [abstract]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_CUST_RULE_PR_DATA     Initializes Manager for Notice Rule Data [abstract]         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_FREE_PROC             Initializes Manager for Indiv. Notice Procedure [abstract]  .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INIT_BY_OTHER                 Initializes Manager with Data of Other Manager              .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INSERT_COPY                   Inserts Data from a Standard Notice Procedure [abstract]    .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Notice Rule (Basic Data Only) [abstract]               .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I INSERT_RULE_COPY              Adds Data from Standard Notice Rule                         .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I IS_RULE_OK                    Is Notice Rule Without Errors?                              .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I IS_SIMUL_CUST_RULE_POSSIBLE   Is It Possible to Simulate Standard Notice Rule?            .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I SET_PROC_PARTY                Changes Party Giving Notice of Notice Rule [abstract]       .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I SET_RULE_DR_ITEMS             Changes Definition of Deadline Regul.(Deadlines) [abstract] .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I SET_RULE_PR_ITEMS             Changes Definition of Period Regul.(Notice Periods)[abstract.
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I SET_SIM_DEFAULTS              Changes Default Values for Simulation Parameter [final]     .
IF_RETM_NOTICE_PROC_MNGR       I SET_TEXT                      Changes Text of Notice Rule [abstract]                      .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Structure                                            .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_BUS_AREA_BY_HIERARCHY     Supplies the Business Area Via the Object Hierarchy         .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Gets Structure on Key Date                                  .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_KEYDATE       Gets Structure Including Addit. Data on Key Date            .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_FAREA_BY_HIERARCHY        Gets Functional Area Using Object Hierarchy                 .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Supplies all Entries for the Term Number                    .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_PRCTR_BY_HIERARCHY        Supplies the Profit Center Via the Object Hierarchy         .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_PROFITCENTER_DATA         Gets Profit Center Data (Create Using BAPI)                 .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I GET_TXJCD_BY_HIERARCHY        Gets Tax Jurisdiction Code via Object Hierarchy             .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Term                                                   .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I SET_PROFITCENTER_DATA         Sets Profit Center Data for Creating Using BAPI             .
IF_RETM_ORG_ASSIGNMENT_MNGR    I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Term                                                .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Structure                                            .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Gets Structure on Key Date                                  .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_KEYDATE       Gets Structure Including Addit. Data on Key Date            .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Supplies all Entries for the Term Number                    .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Term                                                   .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I IS_HOUSEBANK_CHANGEABLE       Asks If House Bank Definition Is Allowed to Be Changed      .
IF_RETM_PAYMENT_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Term                                                .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I CAN_CHANGE_1ST_END_DATE       Is First Contract End Date Changeable?                      .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I CAN_CHANGE_1ST_POSTING_DATE   Can Starting Date of Cash Flow Be Changed?                  .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I CAN_CHANGE_CFPOSTINGFROM_DATE Can Date of 1st Posting Be Changed?                         .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I CAN_CHANGE_START_DATE         Is Contract Start Date Changeable                           .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I CHECK_PERIOD                  Checks Term Data                                            .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Term Data As Field String                          .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Term Data as Field String Incl. Addit. Data        .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I GET_PERIOD                    Supplies Term Data as Individual Fields                     .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I GET_PERIOD_X                  Supplies Term Data as Individual Fields Incl. Add. Data     .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I SET_1ST_END_DATE              Changes First Contract End Date                             .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I SET_1ST_POSTING_DATE          Changes Starting Date of Cash Flow                          .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I SET_CFPOSTINGFROM_DATE        Changes Date of 1st Posting                                 .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I SET_START_DATE                Changes Contract Start Date                                 .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I UPDATE_ABS_END_DATE           Updates Term End (Incl. Notice/Renewal)                     .
IF_RETM_PERIOD_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Term Term                                           .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Renewal Term                                         .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Renewal Term                                       .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Renewal Term Including Addit. Data                 .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I GET_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR         Supplies Renewal Manager                                    .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I HAS_RENEWAL_TERM              Is a Standard or Individual Renewal Rule Defined            .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_MNGR           I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Renewal Term                                        .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I CALC_DATE                     Calculates Next Renewal Date [final]                        .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I CALC_DATE_LIST                Calculates Date Flow for Renewals [final]                   .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Extension Period Exists (Exc.) [final]            .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Definitions of Extension Periods [final] .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I EXISTS                        Checks If Extension Period Exists (Y/N) [final]             .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Basic Data of Renewal Rule [abstract]              .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Basic Data of Renewal Rule + Add. Data [abstract]  .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Assigned Extension Periods [final]             .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Assigned Extension Periods + Add. Data [final] .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_RNAUTTYPE                 Supplies Type of Automatic Renewal [abstract]               .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_SIM_DEFAULTS              Supplies Default Values for Simulation Parameters [final]   .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Text of Renewal Rule [abstract]                    .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Description of Renewal Rule [abstract].
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I HAS_AUTOMATIC                 Checks If There at Least 1 Automatic Renewal [final]        .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I HAS_OPTION                    Checks If Renewal Rule Contains At Least 1 Option [final]   .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I HAS_TEXT_REF                  Is There a Description of Renewal Rule? [Final]             .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_CUST_RULE             Initializes Manager for Standard Renewal Rule [abstract]    .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_CUST_RULE_PR_DATA     Initializes Manager for Renewal Rule Data [abstract]        .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I INIT_BY_FREE_RULE             Initializes Manager for Individual Renewal Rule [abstract]  .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I INSERT_COPY                   Inserts Data from a Standard Renewal Rule [abstract]        .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I SET_LIST                      Changes the Assigned Extension Periods [abstract]           .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I SET_RNAUTTYPE                 Changes Type of Automatic Renewal [abstract]                .
IF_RETM_RENEWAL_RULE_MNGR      I SET_SIM_DEFAULTS              Changes Default Values for Simulation Parameter [final]     .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Structure                                            .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Gets Structure on Key Date                                  .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_KEYDATE       Gets Structure Including Addit. Data on Key Date            .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Supplies all Entries for the Term Number                    .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Term                                                   .
IF_RETM_RHYTHM_MNGR            I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Term                                                .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I CHANGE_PERIOD                 Changes Validity Period [final]                             .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I CHECK_PERIOD_KEY              Checks If Validity Period Exists (Exception) [final]        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I COUNT_PERIODS                 Gets Number of Validity Periods [final]                     .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I DELETE_PERIOD                 Deletes Validity Period [final]                             .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I EXISTS_PERIOD                 Checks If Validity Period Exists (Y/N) [final]              .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I GET_PERIOD_BY_DATE            Gets Validity Period on Date [final]                        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I GET_PERIOD_LIST               Gets the Validity Periods [abstract]                        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I GET_PERIOD_LIST_X             Gets the Validity Periods [final]                           .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TD_TERM_MNGR  I INSERT_PERIOD                 Adds New Validity Period [final]                            .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Entry Exists (Except.) [final]                    .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I CHECK_TERM                    Checks a Term [abstract]                                    .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I COUNT                         Gets Number of Terms [final]                                .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I DELETE_OBJREL                 Deletes Object Assignment                                   .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I EXISTS                        Checks if Term Exists (Y/N) [final]                         .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I EXISTS_ANY_OBJREL             Is at Least One Object Assigned? [final]                    .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_DATE_FOR_NEW_ENTRY        Supplies "Valid-From" Date for a New Entry                  .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_DEFAULT_TEXT              Supplies Standard Term Text According to Detail Data        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_OBJREL_LIST               Supplies List of Assigned Objects [final]                   .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_TERMSUBTYPES_FOR_INSERT   Supplies All Permitted Subtypes for Insert                  .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Term Text [final]                                  .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I GET_TIME_DEPENDENCY_IND       Gets Indicator for Supported Time-Dependency [final]        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I HANDLE_AFTER_DELETE           Event Handler "Term Header: After Deletion"                 .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I HANDLE_AFTER_INSERT           Event Handler "Term Header: After Insertion" [abstract]     .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I HANDLE_BEFORE_DELETE          Event Handler "Term Header: Before Deletion"                .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I HANDLE_BEFORE_INSERT          Event Handler "Term Header: After Insertion"                .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Manager via Superordinate Object [final]        .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I INSERT_OBJREL                 Adds Object Assignment                                      .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I IS_DELETE_ALLOWED             Is deleting an existing term allowed?                       .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I IS_INSERT_ALLOWED             Is adding a new term allowed?                               .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I IS_OBJREL_ALLOWED             Is Object Assignment for Term Permitted? [Final]            .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I IS_OBLIGATORY                 Is Term Required?                                           .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I SET_OBJREL_LIST               Changes List of Assigned Objects [final]                    .
IF_RETM_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR     I SET_TEXT                      Changes Term Text [final]                                   .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I CHECK_KEY                     Checks If Term Exists (Except.)                             .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I COUNT                         Supplies Number of Terms                                    .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I DELETE_DETAIL                 Deletes Term                                                .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I EXISTS                        Checks If Term Exists (Y/N)                                 .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I EXISTS_ANY_TERM               Checks if at least one term exists                          .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure with Additional Data                     .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Terms                                          .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_LIST_X                    Supplies All Terms with Additional Data                     .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_SPECIFIC_TERM_MNGR        Supplies Concrete Term Manager for Term Category            .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TERMSUBTYPES_FOR_INSERT   Supplies All Term Categories to be Added with Subtypes      .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TERMTYPES_ALLOWED         Supplies All Allowed Term Categories                        .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TERMTYPES_FOR_INSERT      Supplies All Term Categories That Can Be Added              .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TERMTYPES_OBLIGATORY      Supplies All Mandatory Term Categories                      .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TEXT                      Supplies Term Text                                          .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I GET_TEXT_REF                  Supplies Reference to Memo                                  .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I INIT_BY_PARENT                Initializes Term Manager via Superordinate Object           .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds New Term                                               .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I IS_DELETE_ALLOWED             Is deleting a given term allowed?                           .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I IS_INSERT_ALLOWED             Is adding a new term allowed?                               .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I SET_TEXT                      Changes Term Text                                           .
IF_RETM_TERM_MNGR              I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Updates Term                                                .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I CHECK_DETAIL                  Checks Structure                                            .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL_BY_KEYDATE         Gets Structure on Key Date                                  .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_DETAIL_X_BY_KEYDATE       Gets Structure Including Addit. Data on Key Date            .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_ITEM_LIST_FI              Gets the FI Withholding Tax Items                           .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_ITEM_LIST_FI_X            Gets the FI Withholding Tax Items Incl. Additional Data     .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_LIST                      Supplies All Entries                                        .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I GET_LIST_BY_TERMNO            Supplies all Entries for the Term Number                    .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I INSERT_DETAIL                 Adds Term                                                   .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I SET_ITEM_LIST_FI              Changes the FI Withholding Tax Items                        .
IF_RETM_WITHHOLDING_TAX_MNGR   I UPDATE_DETAIL                 Changes Term                                                .
IF_REVIEW_NODE                 I EXIT_DIALOG                   Termination of Dialog                                       .
IF_REVIEW_NODE                 I PAI                           Process After Input Treatment                               .
IF_REVIEW_NODE                 I PBO                           Process Before Output Treatment                             .
IF_REVIEW_NODE                 I SET_KW_RELEASE                Transfer KW Release from Dialog                             .
IF_REVIEW_NODE                 I SET_OKCODE                    Sets OK Code in Process After Input                         .
IF_REVIEW_STRUCTURE            I PBO                           Process Before Output Treatment of Structure                .
IF_REVIEW_STRUCTURE            I SAVE                          Saves Structure                                             .
IF_REVIEW_STRUCTURE            I SELECT_QUESTION               Selects Question in Structure                               .
IF_REVIEW_STRUCTURE            I USER_COMMAND                  OK Code Processing                                          .
IF_REVISION_ITEM_DCM           I CHECK_NEW                     Check Whether New Version                                   .
IF_REVISION_ITEM_DCM           I GET_DATA                      Get Data                                                    .
IF_REVISION_ITEM_DCM           I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I COMPLETE_ITEM                 Set Current Version to "Completed"                          .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I CREATE_ITEM                   Create New Version                                          .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I DELETE                        Physically Delete                                           .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_ACTIVITY                  Activity                                                    .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_CURRENT_ITEM              Get Current Version                                         .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_DATA                      Get Data                                                    .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_ITEMS                     Determine Version                                           .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_LAST_ITEM                 Get Last Version                                            .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_NEXT_ITEM                 Get Next Version                                            .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_PREISANZ                  Get Authorization to Display Price Data                     .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I GET_PREVIOUS_ITEM             Get Previous Version                                        .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I IS_CHANGED                    Changed?                                                    .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I IS_CREATE_ALLOWED             New Version Allowed?                                        .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I PROCESS                       Verification                                                .
IF_REVISION_MANAGER_DCM        I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_REXA_APPL_AREA              I GET_DOCTYPE_REV               Delivers Reversal Document Tzpe                             .
IF_REXA_APPL_AREA              I GET_GLACCOUNT                 Gets Account Number                                         .
IF_REXA_APPL_AREA              I INIT                          Initializes Instance                                        .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I CHANGE_SPECIFIC_CUST          Change Customizing Data Prior to Adjustment                 .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I CHANGE_SPECIFIC_OBJECT        Changes Specific or Object Data Before Adjustment           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_ACTUAL_INDEX_BASE         Gets Current Point Level for Today's Date                   .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_ADJ_AMOUNT                Calculate Adjustment Amount from Relative Method            .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_ADJ_PERCENT_MGR           Determine Adjustment Percentage for Mortgage Rate           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_BASE_CONDITIONS_ABS       Condition Amounts for Absolute Method                       .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_CH01_DETAIL_ABS_COND      Gets Infomational Values for Adjustment of Abs. Conditions  .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_CH01_DETAIL_BY_CONDITION  Gets Informational Values for Adjustment of a Condition     .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_CONDITIONS_BY_EXT_PURPOSE Gets the Conditions for External Purpose                    .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_CONDITION_VALUES_ABS      Gets Unit Price and Condition Amount for Absoulte Condition .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_DETAIL_BY_DATE            Gets Rule Data for Date [Final]                             .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_FIRST_ADJM_INDEX_BASE     Supplies Point Level at First Adjustment                    .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_INDEX_BASE_BY_DATE        Gets Point Level for Date                                   .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_INDEX_CHANGE_PERCENT      Gets Percentage Changes in Points                           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_INDEX_CHANGE_POINTS       Gets Absolute Changes in Points                             .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_INDEX_LAST_MAINTAIN       Gets Last Maintained Points with Date                       .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_LAST_ADJM_INDEX_BASE      Supplies Point Level at Last Adjustment                     .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_POINTER_BY_DATE           Gets Rule Pointer for Date [Final]                          .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I GET_RESERVE                   Gets the Reserves                                           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_ABSOLUT_METHOD           Determine Condition Amounts Using Absolute Method           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_ADJ_CONDITION_ABS        Adjust Absolute Conditions from Results of Relative Method  .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_ADJ_ONE_COND_ABS         Adjust an Absolute Method Condition                         .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_PARAM_BY_LOW             Evaluate Parameter "Option for Reduction"                   .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_RELATIV_METHOD           Determine Condition Amounts Using Relative Method           .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_RELATIV_METHOD_MGR       Relative Method Adjustment: Mortgage Rate of Canton Bank    .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_RELATIV_METHOD_MOC       Relative Method Adjustment: Maintenance + Operating Costs   .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I PROC_RELATIV_METHOD_PPC       Relative Method Adjustment: Purchasing Power Protection     .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I SET_BASE_MGR                  Maintain Basic Data for Adjustment Based on Mortgage Rate   .
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I SET_BASE_PPC                  Maintain Basic Data for Adjustment Based on Purch.PowerProt..
IF_REXC_AJMETHOD_CH01          I SET_GUID_IN_OBJCH01           Set GUID in Adjustment Term Data CH01                       .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I DO_PREASSIGNMENT              Carries Out Preassignment When Creating                     .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I GET_VALID_DETAIL              Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I GET_VALID_DETAIL_X            Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I REVERSAL                      In Case of Reversal, Initialize GUID                        .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I SET_ACTIVITY_AFTER_REVERSE    Reset Activity                                              .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I SET_GUID                      Maintain GUID                                               .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I SET_NEW_DETAIL_ROW            Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REXC_AJOBJECT_CH01_MNGR     I SET_VALID_DETAIL              Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REXC_AJSPEC_CH01_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure                                          .
IF_REXC_AJSPEC_CH01_MNGR       I GET_DETAIL_X                  Supplies Structure, Incl. Additional Data                   .
IF_REXC_AJSPEC_CH01_MNGR       I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Field String                                           .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I CALC_CONSUMPTION              Calculate Consumption                                       .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I CALC_STOCK_CHANGE             Calculate Change in Fuel Level                              .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I CHANGE_ENTRY                  Change Entry                                                .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I CHECK_QUANTITY                Check the Quantity in Table BSEG                            .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I DO_FC_POSTING                 Post Consumption                                            .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I DO_OB_POSTING                 Post Initial Level                                          .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I DO_POSTING                    FI Posting                                                  .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I ENTER_FUEL_DATA               Enter Fuel Data After FI Posting                            .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I GET_CHECK_LIST                Create Checklist                                            .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I GET_CONSUMTION_COST           Read Consumption from Completed Settlement                  .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I GET_DATA                      Read Data from Class                                        .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I GET_FI_DATA                   Read Data from Table BSEG                                   .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I GET_FUEL_CONSUMTION           Read Consumption Data from Fuel Table                       .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I IS_OB_PART_OF_CALC            Is the Initial Level Part of Calculated Consumption?        .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I READ                          Read Data from Table VIXCFCFS                               .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I REVERSAL_POSTING              Reverse posting                                             .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I REVERSE_CONSUMTION            Reversal of Consumption Calculation                         .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I SET_BELNR_IN_OB               Setting of Document Number in New Initial Level             .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I SET_DATA                      Return Data to Class                                        .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I SET_FUEL_LEVEL                Write New Fill Level in Fuel Table                          .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I STORE                         Save Data in Table VIXCFCFS                                 .
IF_REXC_FUEL_CONS              I TRANSFER_FUEL_DATA            Transfer of Heating Oil Purchases from Table BSEG           .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I DEQUEUE                       Remove Lock                                                 .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I ENQUEUE                       Sets Lock                                                   .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I FREE                          Releases all resources and locks                            .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Structure for Primary Key                          .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I GET_DETAIL_X                  Gets Structure for Primary Key Incl. Addit. Data            .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I GET_LIST                      Gets All Items                                              .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I GET_LIST_X                    Gets All Items Including Additional Data                    .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I GET_SINGLDOC                  Read Single Document Data                                   .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I INIT_OBJECT                   Initializes the Instance [Abstract]                         .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I MODIFY_CORR_DOC               Create/Change/Delete Adjustment Document                    .
IF_REXC_MS_DATA                I SET_STATUS                    Set Settlement to Active/Inactive                           .
IF_REXC_MS_NOTIONAL_CALC       I GET_LIST                      Gets Data                                                   .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I CALCULATE_AMOUNT              Determine Total Amount and Difference per Due Date          .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I DELETE_ESRREF_HDR             Deletes Assignments                                         .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I DELETE_ESRREF_ITM             Deletes Assignments                                         .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I GET_BUS_OBJECT                Rental Objects of Assigned Lease-Outs                       .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I GET_CONTRACT                  Assigned Lease-Outs                                         .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I GET_HDR_DATA                  Returns Attributes Header from Header Data                  .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I GET_LIST                      Gets Assignments                                            .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I GET_ONETIME_CONDTYPE          One-Time Condition Types of Assigned Lease-Outs             .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I HAS_FLAG_DELETE_ROWS          Checks If Assignments Were Deleted                          .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I HAS_MODIFIED                  Checks If Assignments Were Changed                          .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I HAS_MT_ITM_OLD                Checks If This Is the First Run                             .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I INIT_BY_DATA                  Maintains Attributes Header from Header Data                .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I INIT_BY_ESRREF                Maintains Header Data for ISR Reference                     .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I INIT_BY_ESR_HEADER            Maintains Attributes Header from Header Data                .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I INSERT_ESRREF_HDR             Adds Assignments                                            .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I INSERT_ESRREF_ITM             Adds Assignments                                            .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I SET_ESRREF_HDR                Sets Assignments                                            .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I SET_ESRREF_ITM                Sets Assignments                                            .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I SET_FLAG_DELETE_ROWS          Set Indicator When Assignments Deleted                      .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I UPDATE_ESRREF_HDR             Changes Assignments                                         .
IF_REXC_RA_ESR_ASS             I UPDATE_ESRREF_ITM             Changes Assignments                                         .
IF_REXC_SCCH_RPADDIT           I GET_MEASURING_POINT           Gets All Measuring Points of Rental Object                  .
IF_REXC_SCCH_RPADDIT           I GET_MP_ADDIT                  Gets Additional Data of Measuring Point                     .
IF_REXC_SCCH_RPADDIT           I READ                          Reads All Data from DB                                      .
IF_REXC_SCCH_RPADDIT           I SET_MP_ADDIT                  Changes Additional Data of Measuring Point                  .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I GET_ACCFIRM                   Gets Data of Settlement Company                             .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I GET_MEASURING_POINTS          Gets All Measuring Points                                   .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I GET_TAPE_STATE                Gets Status of Tape                                         .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I READ                          Reads All Data from DB                                      .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I READ_MP                       Reads All Measuring Points of SU from DB                    .
IF_REXC_SCCH_SUADDIT           I SET_ACCFIRM                   Changes Data of Settlement Company                          .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I CANCEL_MR                     Reversal of Measurement Documents                           .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I CONVERT_TAPE_FILE2DB          Convert Tape from File to DB                                .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I CREATE_MP                     Create Measuring Points                                     .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I CREATE_MR                     Create Measurement Documents                                .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I CREATE_RECORDS                Read All Data Necessary for Creating the File               .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I DELETE_TAPE_FROM_DB           Delete Tape Data from DB                                    .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I LOAD_TAPE_FROM_DB             Read Tape Data from DB                                      .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I SAVE_TAPE_TO_DB               Write Tape Data to DB                                       .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I SET_TAPE                      Sets Header Data of Tape                                    .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I SET_TAPE_ITEM                 Sets Tape Items                                             .
IF_REXC_SCCH_TAPE              I UPDATE_STATE                  Modify Status of Tape                                       .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I CLOSE                         Close connection to target system                           .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I CREATE_REMOTE_OBJECT          Create a new object in target system                        .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I GET_LAST_ERROR                Read last error message                                     .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I GET_NAME                      Read name assigned                                          .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I GET_STATUS                    Read current condition                                      .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I GET_SYSTEM_INFO               R%ead system information of target system                   .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I OPEN                          Open connection to target system                            .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I PING                          Ping into target system for connection check                .
IF_RMC_SESSION                 I SET_NAME                      Name assignment for connection                              .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I RAISE_ERROR                   Error handling (exception, message, rabax, ...)             .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I STRUCT_CHG                    Change structure (changing)                                 .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I STRUCT_GET                    Read structure (exporting)                                  .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I STRUCT_PUT                    Send structure (importing)                                  .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I STRUCT_RET                    Read structure (returning)                                  .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I SUM_BCD                       Calculate sum of two BCDs                                   .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I SUM_FLOAT                     Calculate sum of two floats                                 .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I SUM_INT                       Calculate sum of two integers                               .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I TABLE_CHG                     Change table (changing)                                     .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I TABLE_GET                     Read table (exporting)                                      .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I TABLE_PUT                     Send table (importing)                                      .
IF_RMC_VERI_TEST               I TABLE_RET                     Read table (returning)                                      .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I ADD                           adds                                                        .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I DELETE                        Deletes                                                     .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I DESTROY                       Called when the object is destroyed                         .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I DISPLAY                       display subcomponent                                        .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I GET_NEW_INSTANCE              get new instance                                            .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I MODIFY                        Modifies the subcomponent data                              .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I SAVE                          saves the data                                              .
IF_RMPSPB_SUBCOMPONENT_BSP     I UPDATE                        Update an existing item                                     .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I CREATE                        Create Object                                               .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I GET                           Get Object                                                  .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I GET_CLASS                     Get Instance of Defined Class                               .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I GET_LEVEL_CUSTOMIZING         Get Customizing for Category Level                          .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I GET_RMS_ID                    Get RMS ID                                                  .
IF_RMPS_A2RM                   I SET_DATA                      Set Scenario Data (re-initialization)                       .
IF_RMPS_A2RM_VIS               I CALL                          Call (Default: Display)                                     .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I ACL_MAINTAIN                  Maintenance of ACL                                          .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I ACL_SAVE_ON_DB                Save ACL in Database                                        .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I CALL_DIALOG                   Module Call for Maintaining ACL in Dialog                   .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Check of Changes to Data                                    .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I CHECK_NOT_EMPTY               Check if Assigned ACLs Exist                                .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I CLOSE                         Dismantle Control and Container                             .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I CONTAINS                      Contains User/s                                             .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I COPY                          Copy an Access Control List to a New Object                 .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I DELETE_SCREEN_VALUES          Deletion of Contents of ACL in Dialog                       .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I GET_IN_PRINT_FORMAT           Output in Print Format (Case)                               .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I GET_NAME_STRING               Object-Specific Return of Access List as String             .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I INITIALIZE                    Set or Generate a Relation ID                               .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I OUTTAB_SET                    Set Global ACL Table                                        .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I OUTTAB_SET_AFER_CANCEL        Reset Output Table after Termination                        .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I RELID_GET                     Read Attribute RELID                                        .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I SAVE_TENTATIVE                TC: Save temporarily in local buffer                        .
IF_RMPS_ACL                    I UPDATE_GLOBAL_DATA            Reading of Changed Data                                     .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I CLOSE                         Close ACL                                                   .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I GET_NAME_STRING               Get List of Values as a Concatenated String                 .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I OPEN                          Open ACL                                                    .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I SAVE                          Save current set values in DB                               .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I SET_NEW_RELID                 Set New Relation ID for ACL                                 .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I VALUES_CHECK                  Check ACL Values                                            .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I VALUES_GET                    Get Values in List                                          .
IF_RMPS_ACL_API                I VALUES_SET                    Set the values in the list                                  .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I CHECK_ADD_AGENT               Check validity of given agent                               .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I CHECK_INACTIVE                Check if given DLI is deactivated                           .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I DELETE_ROW                    Delete line in global table of ACL_AGENTS                   .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I F4_FOR_AGENTID                F4 Help for AgentId (US or DLI)                             .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I GET_ACL                       Provide global table of ACL_Agents                          .
IF_RMPS_ACL_MAINTAIN           I INSERT_ROWS                   Insert new lines in global table of ACL_AGENTS              .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I DELETE_TEMP_ATTR              Delete Temporary Attribute                                  .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I GET_ATTRIBUTS                 Read Attributes                                             .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Interface Instance                                      .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I GET_SEL_OPTIONS               Set Selection Parameter                                     .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I GET_TEMP_ATTR                 Read attributes not filed in IP                             .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I SET_ATTRIBUTS                 Set Attributes                                              .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I SET_SEL_OPTIONS               Set Selection Parameter                                     .
IF_RMPS_ATTRIBUTS              I SET_TEMP_ATTR                 Set attributes not filed in IP                              .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_ACL_OBJECTS               Get Objects for Managing ACLs (User/Distribution Lists)     .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_ATTRIBUTES_TO_GENERATE    Get table of attributes that can be generated               .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_CASE_POID                 Get Case POID                                               .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_CHANGED_ATTRIBUTES        Get List of Changed Attributes                              .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_EXPORT_XML_HANDLER        Get Object for Export                                       .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_FOI_OBJECTS               Get Objects for Handling FOI Data                           .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_GENERATABLES_HANDLER      Get object for handling attributes that can be generated    .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_MAIL_HANDLER              Get Object for Recursive Mailing of Case                    .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_MULTIPLE_VALUES_HANDLER   Get obj f. handling attr. that can be evaluated in mul. ways.
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_OVERRIDDEN_INHERITED      Get Object for Handling Overridden Inherited Attributes     .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_PRINT_HANDLER             Get Object for Recursive Printing of Case                   .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_REFERENCE_HANDLER         Get Object for Handling Case Indicator                      .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_REPOSITORY_CHANGES        Get Object for Monitoring Attribute Changes                 .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_VIRTUAL_ATTRIBUTES        Get Vitual Attributes of Case                               .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I GET_VIRTUAL_ATTRIBUTES_HANDLERGet Object for Handling Virtual Attributes                  .
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I IS_INSERT_IN_MULT_CASES_ALLOWDIs inserting an el. allowed if it's already in another case?.
IF_RMPS_CASE                   I VALIDATE_CASE_ATTRIBUTES      Specific Attribute Checks                                   .
IF_RMPS_CASE_ACTIVITY          I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Executing an Activity Function                              .
IF_RMPS_CASE_ACTIVITY          I EXECUTE_SPECIAL               For Special Functions (signature)                           .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I ACCEPT                        Transfer Data                                               .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I DIALOG                        Dialog- Container must be entered                           .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I DIALOG_POPUP                  Dialog (Popup)                                              .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I GET                           Get data                                                    .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I GET_EXPORT                    Get Texts for Export/Presentation                           .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I GET_IN_PRINT_FORMAT           Get Print Output (Case Format)                              .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I GET_TEXT                      Get Text for Key List (IM_NAME)                             .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I REFRESH_TEXTS_DIALOG          Refresh Texts in OUTTAB (in DIALOG)                         .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I SAVE                          Save in DB                                                  .
IF_RMPS_CASE_MULTIPLE_VALUES   I SET                           Set data                                                    .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I CALL_LIST                     Construct List                                              .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I CONTEXT_MENU                  Make Context Menu Available                                 .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I EXECUTE                       Make Command Available from Context Menu                    .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I EXPAND                        Open                                                        .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I FILL                          Make Entries in Work Basket                                 .
IF_RMPS_DESK_FOLDER            I GET_CUSTOMIZING_NAME          Get Name for Customizing (hiding of options)                .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I ADD_SIGN                      Sign - Multiple Signature for Other Users                   .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I ADD_SIGNATURE_ACTIVITIES      Add Signature Activities to Activity List                   .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I CHECK_IF_SIGNED               Check whether document is already signed                    .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I CONVERT_DOCUMENT              Convert Document                                            .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I DELETE_SIGNATURE_DOCUMENT     Delete Signed "Shadow" Document for Given Document          .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I GET_DOC_TYPE_INFO             Get Information for Document or Mime Type                   .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I GET_FILENAME_INFO             Get Information on Given File Name                          .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I GET_RESULT_FROM_REQUEST       Get Result of a Signature Activity from the Request         .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I GET_SIGNATURE_DOCUMENT        Get Document's Signed "Shadow" Document                     .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I GET_SPS_FOR_SIGNED_DOCUMENTS  Get SPS ID under which signed documents are stored          .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization (execute before calling instance methods)    .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I SHOW_VERIFICATION_HISTORY     Display History of OCSP Verification Runs                   .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I SHOW_VERIFY_RESULTS           Display Verification Results                                .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I SIGN                          Sign                                                        .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I SIGN_FIRST_TIME               Sign - First Signature of a Document                        .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I VERIFY                        Verify                                                      .
IF_RMPS_DIGITIAL_SIGNATURE     I VERIFY_RAW_DATA               Check Signature                                             .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST           I CREATE                        Generate Element List Starting from n Start Objects         .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST           I GET_ELEMENT_LIST              Get Element List                                            .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST           I SET_ELEMENT_LIST              Set Element List                                            .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST_CALLBACK  I CUSTOM_CONTAINER_CREATED      Custom Container Created in Dialog Box                      .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST_CALLBACK  I POPUP_CLOSED                  Dialog Box Closed (-"Release Controls...)                   .
IF_RMPS_ELEMENT_LIST_INTERN    I ADD_ELEMENT                   Add Element                                                 .
IF_RMPS_EXCHANGE_CONTENT       I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of POID Object                                  .
IF_RMPS_EXCHANGE_LOG_DATA      I GET_LOG_DATA                  Get Log Information from POID Object                        .
IF_RMPS_EXCHANGE_META_DATA     I GET_META_DATA                 Get Metadata of POID Object                                 .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I GENERATE_FIRST_ALL_AUTOMATIC  Generate All Attr. Flagged Automat. (gen. profile) 1st Time .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I GENERATE_FIRST_WITH_PRESET    Generate 1 Attribute with Value Assignment for 1st Time     .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I GET_SESSIONS_INTERFACE        Get Methods for Handling Generation Sessions                .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of the Object                                .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I PREPARE_TO_UNRESERVE_ALL      Release of All Gen. Attr. Prepared (before deletion of obj) .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I UNRESERVE_PREPARED            Release Prepared Attributes (after deletion of object)      .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_ATTRIBUTES I UPDATE_WITHIN_OPERATION       Reassign Generatable Attr. in Recursive Operation           .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_SESSIONS   I ALL_SESSIONS_DESTROY          End All Sessions, Delete Prereservations                    .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_SESSIONS   I ALL_SESSIONS_GET              Get All Created Reference Sessions                          .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_SESSIONS   I ALL_SESSIONS_SAVE_PRERESERVED Reserve Last Prereserved Indicator, Delete Others           .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_SESSIONS   I SESSION_FOR_ATTR_CREATE       Create Reference Session for Given Generatable Attribute    .
IF_RMPS_GENERATABLE_SESSIONS   I SESSION_FOR_ATTR_GET          Get Reference Session for Given Generatable Attribute       .
IF_RMPS_GEN_EXPORT_XML_HANDLER I GET_GENERIC_EXPORT_XML_HANDLERGet Generic Export Handler                                  .
IF_RMPS_GEN_REFERENCE_HANDLER  I GET_GENERIC_REFERENCE_HANDLER Get Generic Reference Handler                               .
IF_RMPS_INBOUND_XML_PROC       I CONVERT_XML_TO_ATTRIBUTS      Create RMPS Attributes from XML                             .
IF_RMPS_INBOUND_XML_PROC       I GET_INSTANCE                  Create Instance                                             .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I ASSIGN_ATTRIBUTE_TO_CLASS     Add Attribute to Class                                      .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I CREATE_AND_ASSIGN_ATTRIBUTES  Create attributes and add them to a class                   .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I DELETE_ATTRIBUTES             Delete Attributes                                           .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I ENTITY_CHECK_EXISTENCE        Check existence of an entity (attribute, class)             .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I ENTITY_GET_PACKAGE            Get package of an entity (attribute, class)                 .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I ENTITY_WHERE_USED_LIST        Get where-used list for an entity                           .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I GET_CLASS_ATTRIBUTES          Get list of attributes of a class                           .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I HIDE_ATTRIBUTES_AT_CLASS      Set attributes in class to "hidden"                         .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I SELECT_CLASS_ATTRIBUTE        Creates List Popup                                          .
IF_RMPS_KPRO_CM_EDIT           I SET_DDIC_REF_FOR_ATTRIBUTE    Set DDIC reference for existing IO attribute                .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I CREATE_BIDIRECTIONAL          Create Bi-Directional Link in PDIR                          .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I CREATE_BIDIRECTIONAL_BUFFERED Create Bi-Directional Link in Buffer                        .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I DELETE_ALL_LINKS              Completely Delete All Links                                 .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I DELETE_ALL_LINKS_BUFFERED     Delete All Links in Buffer                                  .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I DELETE_BIDIRECTIONAL          Delete Bi-Directional Link in PDIR                          .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I DELETE_BIDIRECTIONAL_BUFFERED Delete Bi-Directional Link in Buffer                        .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I EXECUTE                       Display, Create, Delete Links                               .
IF_RMPS_LINKS_EXT              I GET_ALL_LINKS                 Read All Links                                              .
IF_RMPS_MENU_CTRL              I DO                            Execute Menu Customizing                                    .
IF_RMPS_MENU_CTRL              I DO_CODES                      Execute Menu Customizing - Codes                            .
IF_RMPS_MENU_CTRL              I GET_DISABLED                  Get Deactivated Functions                                   .
IF_RMPS_MENU_CTRL              I SET_CUSTOMIZING               Set Customizing Flag                                        .
IF_RMPS_MENU_CTRL              I SET_PROFILE                   Set Profiles                                                .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I DISPLAY                       Display the Log                                             .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I DISPLAY_GIVEN_PROTOCOL        Display transferred log entries (example: from several obj.).
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I FORMAT_OBJECT_PROT            Convert Basis Log to Merged Log                             .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I GET_ALV_SETTINGS              Get Settings for the Log Display in an ALV                  .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I GET_PRINT_LINES               Get Print Data in Hierarchy Display                         .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I READ                          Read Current Log Entries                                    .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I RELOAD_BEFORE_NEXT_DISPLAY    Load Log Data Before Next Display                           .
IF_RMPS_MERGED_PROTOCOL        I SET_POID_DIR_ID               Set PoidDirId of Objects(subclasses can be used for reading).
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION             I CREATE                        Create a New Mass Operation                                 .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION             I CREATE_RUN                    Create a New Mass Operation Run                             .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION             I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Operation Parameter (Value Amount)                      .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_ELIST       I GET_ELEMENT_LIST              Get Element List                                            .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_ELIST       I INITIALIZE                    Initialization (must be carried out at the beginning)       .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_META        I GET_LOG_CONFIGURATION         Get Configuration for Operation Log                         .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_META        I GET_SINGLE_OP_CLASSROLE       Get Class Role of Recursive Individual Operation            .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_META        I GET_TYPE                      Get Operation Type                                          .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_META        I GET_TYPE_DESCRIPTION          Get Short Description of Operation Type                     .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_READ        I GET_OPERATIONS                Get Individual Operations Belonging to Mass Operation       .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_RUN         I END                           End Run                                                     .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_RUN         I GET_ID                        Get Internal Key of Run                                     .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_RUN         I GET_MOPERATION                Get Mass Operation Belonging to Run                         .
IF_RMPS_MOPERATION_RUN         I START                         Start Run                                                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION              I CREATE                        Create a New Operation                                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION              I CREATE_RUN                    Create a New Operation Run                                  .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION              I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Operation Parameter (Value Amount)                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I GET_NEW_CONT_4_START_OBJECT   Get Future Container of Start Object                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I GET_OPERATION_VARIANT         Get Operation Var. (if not set -" reassign)                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I GET_PAR_ATTR_LIST_2_UPDATE    Get Parameter: List of Attributes to be Updated             .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I GET_PAR_INTERACTIVE_GENERATIONGet Parameter: Interactive Generation for Start Object?     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I SET_NEW_CONT_4_START_OBJECT   Set Future Container of Start Object                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I SET_OPERATION_VARIANT         Set Operation Var.: Reassignment or Attr. Update            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I SET_PAR_ATTR_LIST_2_UPDATE    Set Parameter: List of Attr. to be Updated                  .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_CNG_REF      I SET_PAR_INTERACTIVE_GENERATIONSet Parameter: Interactive Generation for Start Object?     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I GET_ELEMENT_LIST              Get Element List                                            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I GET_PARAM_ATTR_SCOPE          Get Par.: Scope of Attribute Info for Objects (Def.:FW_STD) .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I GET_PARAM_CHK_LIST_PERMISSION Get Parameter: Check List Authorization?                    .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I GET_PARAM_ELEM_UNIQUE         Get Par.: Only deliver el. once if multi. occur.(def: false).
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I INITIALIZE                    Initialization (must be carried out at the beginning)       .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I SET_ELEMENT_DATA              Set List Information for an Element                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I SET_PARAM_ATTR_SCOPE          Set Par.: Scope of Attribute Info for Objects               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I SET_PARAM_CHK_LIST_PERMISSION Set Parameter: Check List Authorization?                    .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_ELIST        I SET_PARAM_ELEM_UNIQUE         Set Par: Only deliver el once if there are multi occurrances.
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_EXPORT_XML   I EXPORT_DATA                   Export Case/Generic SP Data (attributes, log, content)      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_EXPORT_XML   I INITIALIZE_JOB                Initialization Export Job                                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_EXPORT_XML   I STORE2FILESYSTEM_JOB          Start Export to File System                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I ADD_CASE_VIRTUAL_ATTRS        Add virtual case attributes to print/mail table             .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I CLOSE_MAIL_REQUEST            End Mail Request (BCS)                                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I CREATE_MAIL_REQUEST           Initialization of Mail Request (BCS)                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_BOR_LINK                 Send BOR Link by Mail (BCS)                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_CASE_ATTRIBUTES          Send Attribute Case by Mail (BCS)                           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_CASE_ATTRIBUTES_XML      XML Conversion CASE                                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_DOCUMENT_CONTENT         Send Document Contents by Mail (BCS)                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_GENSP_ATTRIBUTES         Send Attribute Generic SP by Mail (BCS)                     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_GENSP_ATTRIBUTES_XML     XML Convertion Generic SP                                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_POID_LIST                Send Several (Start) Elements Recursively in a Mail         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_MAIL         I MAIL_POSTINCOME_CONTENT       Send Contents of Incoming Post Item by Mail (BCS)           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_META         I GET_LOG_CONFIGURATION         Get Configuration for Operation Log                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_META         I GET_TYPE                      Get Operation Type                                          .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_META         I GET_TYPE_DESCRIPTION          Get Short Description of Operation Type                     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I CLOSE_PRINT_JOB               Finish Printing Job                                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I OPEN_PRINT_JOB                Initialization Printing Job                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I PRINT_CASE_ATTRIBUTES         Print Case Attributes                                       .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I PRINT_DOCUMENT_CONTENT        Print Contents of Documents                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I PRINT_GENSP_ATTRIBUTES        Print Attributes Generic SP                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I PRINT_POSTINCOME_CONTENT      Print Contents of Incoming Post Item                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT        I PRINT_SIGNED_DOCUMENT_CONTENT Print Contents of Signed Documents                          .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT_INTERN I SET_PRINT_PARAMETERS_BY_USER  Query and Set Print Parameters from User                    .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_PRINT_INTERN I SUPPORTED_MIMETYP_FOR_PRINTINGIs mime type supported in printing?                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_CREATING_USER             Get User that Created Operation                             .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_CREATION_DATE             Get Time of Creation (UTC time stamp in short form)         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get Name to be Displayed                                    .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_ID                        Get Internal Key of Operation (GUID)                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_PARAMETERS                Get Operation Parameter (value set)                         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_START_OBJECTS             Get Start Objects of Operation                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_TYPE                      Get Operation Type                                          .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I GET_TYPE_DESCRIPTION          Get Description of Operation Type                           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I IS_RECURSIVE                  Should the operation be executed recursively?               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_READ         I IS_START_OBJECT               Is the object specified the start object of op.?            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I END                           End Run                                                     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I EXECUTE_FOR_POID              Execute Operation on Given POID (such as child object)      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_CURRENT_START_OBJECT      Get POID of start object currently being processed          .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_ID                        Get Internal Key of Run                                     .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_OPERATION                 Get Operation Belonging to Run                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS     Get interface for objects involved in run                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL    Get interface for log of operation run                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I GET_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS     Get interface for results of run                            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I START                         Start Run                                                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN          I VISUALIZE_END_OF_OP_RUN       Displays end of a run (display log if errors occur)         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJCNT   I GET_NEXT_OP_OBJ_ID            Get Next Object Number                                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS  I GET_OBJECTS_STATUS_COUNT      Get Number of Objects with a Particular Status              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS  I GET_OBJECT_STATE              Get Object Status                                           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS  I GET_OP_OBJ_ID_FOR_POID_ID     Get 1st operation object ID for given POIDID                .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS  I REGISTER_OBJECT               Add Object (Register)                                       .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJECTS  I SET_OBJECT_STATE              Set Object Status                                           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJ_INFO I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description of Object                                   .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJ_INFO I GET_HIERARCHY_LEVEL           Get Hierarchy Level in Tree of Op. Objects Involved         .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJ_INFO I GET_PARENT_OP_OBJ_ID          Get ID of Subordinate Operation Object                      .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJ_INFO I GET_POID                      Get POID for Operation Object                               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_OBJ_INFO I GET_POID_ID                   Get POID ID for Operation Object                            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I GET_LOG_HANDLE                Get Log Handle                                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I GET_LOG_MESSAGES_VIA_TAB      Gets Log Entries as Message Table                           .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I SAVE                          Save Log in Database                                        .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I SHOW                          Display the Log                                             .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I WRITE_EXCEPTION               Write Exception to Operation Log                            .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I WRITE_MESSAGE                 Write Message to Operation Log                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_PROTOCOL I WRITE_TEXT                    Write Text to Operation Log                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I GET_RESULTS                   Get Results                                                 .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I GET_RESULTS_FOR_POID_ID       Get results for given POID ID                               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I GET_RESULT_OBJ                Get Result Value (Type Object)                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I GET_RESULT_STR                Get Result Value (Type String)                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I GET_RESULT_TAB                Get Result Value (type table)                               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I REMOVE_RESULT                 Delete Result                                               .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I SET_RESULT_OBJ                Set Result Value (Type Object)                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I SET_RESULT_STR                Set Result Value (Type String)                              .
IF_RMPS_OPERATION_RUN_RESULTS  I SET_RESULT_TAB                Set Result Value (type table)                               .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I GET_INSTANCE                  Generate Instance (not a singleton)                         .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I HIDE                          Work center no longer visible                               .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I REFRESH                       Reconstruct Display                                         .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I REFRESH_RESUBMISSIONS         Reconstruct Resubmissions                                   .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I SAVE_SETTINGS                 Save User Settings                                          .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I SHOW                          For Display                                                 .
IF_RMPS_ORGANIZER_TREE         I STORE_EXPANDED_NODES          Save Open Nodes                                             .
IF_RMPS_PLAN                   I CLOSE                         Save                                                        .
IF_RMPS_PLAN                   I F4                            F4 at Fileplan                                              .
IF_RMPS_PLAN                   I F4_GET_ALL                    Get All "Valid" Fileplans                                   .
IF_RMPS_PLAN                   I FOLDER_DELETE                 Delete Cases from Fileplan                                  .
IF_RMPS_PLAN                   I FOLDER_INSERT                 Add Cases in AP (only links)                                .
IF_RMPS_POST_ACTIVITY          I HANDLE_EVENTANSWER            Processing of Response to Event Triggered                   .
IF_RMPS_PRINT                  I GET_PRINT_REC_HIERARCHY       Print Record Structure                                      .
IF_RMPS_PRINT                  I PRINT_ELEMENT_DETAILED        Print Detail of Record Element                              .
IF_RMPS_PRINT                  I PRINT_RECORD_ELEMENT          Print Record Element Recursively                            .
IF_RMPS_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI        I CHECK_VALUES_CHANGED          Check whether values were changed                           .
IF_RMPS_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI        I GET_SCREEN_VALUES             Get Values in Current Attribute Display                     .
IF_RMPS_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI        I SET_SCREEN_VALUES             Set values in curr. attr. display(accdng to GetScreenValues).
IF_RMPS_PRO_AGGREGATION        I GET_AGGREGATION               Get Position of Object in Object Hierarchy                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_AUTH_CHECK         I DECLARE_CHECK                 Access Check for Declaration                                .
IF_RMPS_PRO_AUTH_CHECK         I EXECUTE                       Execution of PRO-Specific Authorization Check               .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I CHECK_ASSIGNED                Checks if the object has already been assigned              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I CHECK_ATTR_DIALOG             Ask as Last Chance to Change Attributes                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I CHECK_DECLARATION_STATE       Determine Declaration State                                 .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I DECLARE_OBJECT                Declare Object                                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I GET_ANCHOR                    Get Anchor for Insert                                       .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I GET_DECLARE_BUTTON            Get Declaration Pushbutton                                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I GET_MOVE_BUTTON               Get Move Button                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I MOVE_OBJECT                   Move object from one folder to another                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_EXE    I SELECT_FOLDER                 Select a Folder                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DECLARATION_HANDLE I GET_DECLARATION_HANDLER       Get Declaration Handler                                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV       I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Returns the Selected Lines                                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV       I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV       I TEST_SELECTED_ROWS            Checks that at least one line was selected                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV       I UPDATE_ALV_TABLE              Refreshes ALV Table                                         .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALVREPORT I TABLE_REFRESH                 Fills ALV Table                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I CLEAR_SELECTED_ROWS           Deletes Line Markings                                       .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I GET_EXPSTAT_TEXT              Reads Export Long Text                                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Returns the Selected Lines                                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I SET_TEXT_FOR_PRINTOUT         Text Variables for Print Output                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I TABLE_REFRESH                 The ALV Table is Re-Copied                                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I TEST_SELECTED_ROWS            Checks that at least one line was selected                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_ALV_GEN   I UPDATE_ALV_TABLE              Deletes Lines Due to a Copy Index                           .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_OBJECT    I CHECK_COMMENT                 Check that a comment was entered                            .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_OBJECT    I EXECUTE_PROCESS               Executes the Disposal Process                               .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_OBJECT    I INSTANCE_GET                  Returns Reference to Object                                 .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_OBJECT    I SAVE_TEXT                     Saves text as SAPscript and returns the text key            .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_OBJECT    I TEXT_DELETE                   Deletes the Text Field                                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I DISPOSAL_INSTRUCTION_GET      Disposal Action (Review, Export, Transfer, Destruction)     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I EFFECTIVE_DATE_GET            Effective Disposal Date                                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I EVENT_CATEGORY_GET            Type of Event: Internal / External(singular / instance-dep.).
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I IS_IMMEDIATE_DESTR            Checks whether rule has event "immediate destruction"       .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I PERIOD_GET                    Disposal Period                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SCHEDULE  I REFERRED_PROPERTY_GET         Attribute that refers to the event (int/ext instance-dep.)  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I ALV_TABLES_GET                Creates ALV Tables (one for each disposal action)           .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I CHECK_CONFLICTS               Checks object for conflicts that cannot be resolved         .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I DISPLAY_DUE_OBJECTS           Fills the ALV with Due Objects                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I EXECUTE_DISPOSAL              Execute the Disposal Action                                 .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_DISPOSAL_SESSION   I LOG_INFORMATION               Logs Important Data of Disposal Session                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I ADD_PART                      Add Part                                                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I CLOSE_PART                    Close Part                                                  .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I CREATE_FIRST_PART             Create First Part                                           .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I GET_FOLDER_CASE_TYPE          Determine Case Type for Folder                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I GET_FOLDER_SPS_ID             Determine Case SPS ID for Folder                            .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER             I SET_FOLDER                    Set Folder (initialize)                                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I ADD_FOLDER_TO_HISTORY         Add Selected Folder to History                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I ATTRIBUT_SELECT               Folder Selection Using Attribute Search                     .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I DISPLAY                       Display Folder Selection                                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I FCODE_HANDLER                 FCode Processing                                            .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I FILEPLAN_SELECT               Folder Selection Using Fileplan                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I FREE                          Destruction of Control                                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I GET_DECLARE_SEL_TYPE          Get Selection Type for Declare                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I GET_SELECTED_FOLDER           Read Folder that Is Currently Selected                      .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I GET_SELECTED_SUBELEMENT       Get Subelement                                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I GET_SUBELEMENTS               Get Subobjects                                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_FOLDER_SELECTION   I INITIALIZE                    Define Global Parameters                                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I DATA_CHANGED                  Data changed?                                               .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I GET_DATA                      Get data                                                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I GET_EXPORT                    Get Texts for Export/Presentation                           .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I GET_IN_PRINT_FORMAT           Print Format                                                .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I GET_NAME_STRING               Change Data in Output String                                .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I GET_OVERALL_FLAG              Is a flag, yes?                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I INITIALIZE                    Initialize (?)                                              .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I MAINTAIN                      Maintenance                                                 .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_RMPS_PRO_GROUP              I SET_DATA                      Set data                                                    .
IF_RMPS_PRO_PRESENTATION       I ACTIVITY_ADD                  Add Instance Activity                                       .
IF_RMPS_PRO_PRESENTATION       I POID_PRESENTATION             External Presentation of a POID                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_RELATION           I CREATE_RELATION               Generate New Relation                                       .
IF_RMPS_PRO_RELATION           I DELETE_RELATION               Delete Relation                                             .
IF_RMPS_PRO_RELATION           I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_RMPS_PRO_RELATION           I GET_RELATIONS                 Get Relations for Object                                    .
IF_RMPS_REFERENCE              I GET_DESTINATION_VALUES        Determine target values for reassgnt by indicator comparison.
IF_RMPS_REFERENCE              I GET_REFERENCE_FOR_POID        Get unique indicator for given POID object                  .
IF_RMPS_REFERENCE              I GET_RULE_ELEM_PROPERTIES      Get value of rule element (using el. name) from indicator   .
IF_RMPS_REFERENCE              I GET_VALUE_FROM_REFERENCE      Get value of rule element (using el. name) from indicator   .
IF_RMPS_REFERENCE              I RECREATE_REFERENCE            Generate new indicator or regenerate ex. indicator          .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION           I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION           I DIALOG                        Dialog: Display, Change, Delete?                            .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION           I EXECUTE                       Execute FCode                                               .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION           I SAVE                          Save in Database                                            .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION           I SET_DONE                      Set current resubmission to complete; evaluate resub. tmpl  .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_API       I GET                           Get Resubmission Instance                                   .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_API       I GET_NEW                       Get Resubmission Instance                                   .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_CR        I GET                           Get Resubmission Instance                                   .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_CR        I GET_ALL                       Get Resubmission Instance                                   .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_CR        I GET_LIST                      Display RM List                                             .
IF_RMPS_RESUBMISSION_CR        I SHOW_POPUP                    Display Dialog Box with Resubmissions                       .
IF_RMPS_SCAN                   I GET_BATCHCLASSES              Read Batch Classes of Scan Software                         .
IF_RMPS_SCAN                   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance (Singleton)                                    .
IF_RMPS_SCAN                   I START                         Start Scan (with Batch Class)                               .
IF_RMPS_SET_ATTRIBUTE_GROUPS   I CONVERT_PROPERTIES_ALV        Conversion of ALV Attributes                                .
IF_RMPS_SP_AROUND_DELETION     I AFTER_DELETION                Execute actions after deletion (such as release of ind.)    .
IF_RMPS_SP_AROUND_DELETION     I BEFORE_DELETION               Execute actions before deletion (such as saving data)       .
IF_RMPS_SP_AROUND_DELETION     I CHECK_DELETION_ALLOWED        Check whether deletion of object is allowed                 .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I AFTER_DOCUMENT_DELETION       Actions After Deletion of a Document                        .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I AUTH_BUFFER_NO_RESET          Reset Authorization Buffer for the Last Time                .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I BEFORE_DOCUMENT_DELETION      Actions Before Deletion of a Document                       .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_EXPORT_XML_HANDLER        Get Object for Export                                       .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_MAIL_HANDLER              Get Object for Mailing Document                             .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_PRINT_HANDLER             Get Object for Printing Document                            .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_REFERENCE_HANDLER         Get Object for Handling Document Number                     .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_SIGNATURE_HANDLER         Get Object for Handling Digital Signature                   .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I GET_SIGNATURE_STATE           Get Result of Last Signature Check                          .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I REPAIR                        Repair (for attributes)                                     .
IF_RMPS_SP_DOCUMENT            I SET_SIGNATURE_STATE           Set Result of Last Signature Check                          .
IF_RMPS_SP_ELEMENT_LIST        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get Element Attributes                                      .
IF_RMPS_SP_ELEMENT_LIST        I GET_CONTENT_RECORD_API        Get Record API for Content (Subordinate Objects)            .
IF_RMPS_SP_OPERATION           I EXECUTE                       Execute Recursive Operation (and Start for Children)        .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I CHECK_INSERT_ALLOWED          Inserting document in record/case allowed?                  .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I CHECK_MIME_HANDLING           Returns how the mime header should be displayed             .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I COPY_PES                      Copies an Incoming Post Item                                .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Creation of Document                                        .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I DELETE_INBOUND_DOC            Deletion of Incoming Post Item                              .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_CONTENT                   Read Contents                                               .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_DOC_VAR                   Gets Document and Variant                                   .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_EXPORT_XML_HANDLER        Get Object for Export                                       .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_MAIL_HANDLER              Get Object for Handling Unique Indicator                    .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_MIME_HEADER               Reading of Mime Header                                      .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_PES_TYPE                  Read Type of Incoming Post Item                             .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_PROPERTIES                Read Characteristics in Variant                             .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Characteristics in Variant                             .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_PROTOCOL_HANDLER          Get Log Object                                              .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I GET_REFERENCE_HANDLER         Get Object for Handling Unique Indicator                    .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I REPAIR                        Repair (for attributes)                                     .
IF_RMPS_SP_POSTBACKEND         I WRITE_PROTOCOL_ENTRY          Write a Log Entry                                           .
IF_RMPS_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY      I RESET_PROTO_DISPLAY_NAME      Reset the buffered display name of object                   .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I AUTH_BUFFER_NO_RESET          Reset Authorization Buffer for the Last Time                .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I GET_EXPORT_XML_HANDLER        Get Object for Export                                       .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I GET_MAIL_HANDLER              Get Object for Mailing Record                               .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I GET_PRINT_HANDLER             Get Object for Printing of Record                           .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I GET_REFERENCE_HANDLER         Get Object for Handling Reference Number                    .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I INIT_PROPERTIES               Initialize the attributes                                   .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD              I UPDATE_DESCRIPTION_FOR_POID   Update Display of Element in Record                         .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT      I REC_ELEM_BEFORE_DELETE        Time before removal of record element (POID)                .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT      I REC_ELEM_BEFORE_DROP          Time Before Drop Record Element (POID)                      .
IF_RMPS_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT      I REC_ELEM_BEFORE_INSERT        Time Before Inserting Element                               .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I ATTRIBUTE_CURRENT_PART_GET    Get POID from Attribute "Current Part"                      .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I CLOSE_PART                    Close Current Part                                          .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I CLOSE_PREVIOUS_PARTS          Check old parts and close if necessary                      .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I CREATE_PART                   Create Part                                                 .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I DOCUMENTS_ALL_DECLARED_CHECK  Check whether all documents in part are declared            .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I GET_BASE_CONTROL              Get Base Control                                            .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I GET_PART_POID_FROM_REQUEST    Get POID of sending part from request if available          .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I INSERT_PART_IN_FOLDER         Add New Part to Folder                                      .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I IS_CLOSED                     Part is closed                                              .
IF_RMPS_SUBCOMPONENT_PART      I NEW_PART                      Create New Part in Folder                                   .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I EXECUTE_FCODE                 Execute FCODE from Context Menu                             .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I GET_INSTANCE                  Instance of Work Item Class (re-create if necessary)        .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I OTHER_WORKITEMS_GET           Get all work items that do not belong to the task list      .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I RAISE_PROCESSING_ERROR        Trigger Event "STOP_FURTHER_ITEMS"                          .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I RAISE_WORKITEM_CLOSED         Trigger Event "WORKITEM_CLOSED"                             .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I STATUS_TO_ICON                Find Icon for Work Item Status                              .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WF_ITEM_EXECUTE               Execute Work Item                                           .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WF_ITEM_FORWARD               Forward Work Item                                           .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WF_ITEM_PUT_BACK              Replace work item                                           .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WF_ITEM_RESUBMIT              Resubmission (Workflow Item)                                .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WF_ITEM_SHOW_PROCESS_DATA     Display Log                                                 .
IF_RMPS_WORKITEM               I WORKLIST_GET                  Get List of Work Items                                      .
IF_RMPS_XML_OBJECT             I ATTRIBUTES_GET                Delivers Attributes of XML Object as Reference Table        .
IF_RMPS_XML_OBJECT             I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_XML_PRO                I XML_FOR_POID_GET              Get Additional XML Info                                     .
IF_RMPS_XML_TRANSFORMATION     I ABAP_TO_XML                   Generates the XML Display of a POID                         .
IF_RMPS_XML_TRANSFORMATION     I INSTANCE_GET                  Generates Instance and Returns Reference                    .
IF_RMPS_XML_TRANSFORMATION     I XML_TO_ABAP                   Generates ABAP Data Objects from an XML String              .
IF_RMPS_XML_TRANSFORMATION     I XML_TO_ABAP_PRE_INFO          Delivers Required Info Before Transf. (processing class,...).
IF_RMSA_API_EVT                I ON_OBJ_CHANGE                 Method for Transferring Changed Objects                     .
IF_RMSA_INFOSYSTEM             I DEL_OBJECT                    Delete Objects                                              .
IF_RMSA_LASTAT                 I ON_NOTIFY_UPDATE              QM Object Was Changed                                       .
IF_RMSA_LASTAT                 I READ_KEYDATA                  Read Key Data of Higher-Level Object                        .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I APPLOG_WRITE                  Write Application Log                                       .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I CHECK                         Check Selected Data Records                                 .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I FIELDCAT_MODIFY               Modify Field Catalog for Dialog                             .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I MASSCHANGE                    Execute Mass Change for Selected Data Records               .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I MSCHNG_BACKGROUND             Execute Mass Change in Background                           .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I ON_ITEMNO_CHANGED             On Change to Row Number                                     .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I ON_ROW_CHANGED                Check Changed Row                                           .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I OUTTAB_GET                    Get Output Table                                            .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I PARAMETERS_SET                Pass Parameters                                             .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I RENUMBER                      Renumbering                                                 .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I RESET                         Reset Parameters                                            .
IF_RMSA_MSCHNG                 I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_RMSA_PARENT                 I CHECK_FOR_TOGGLE              Check for Locking Concept Whether to Toggle When Leaving    .
IF_RMSA_QM                     I ON_NOTIFY_UPDATE              QM Object Was Changed                                       .
IF_RMSA_QM                     I READ_KEYDATA                  Read Key Data of Higher-Level Object                        .
IF_RMSA_STATUS                 I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Get Instance                                                .
IF_RMSA_STATUS                 I ON_STATUS_CHANGE              Check for Changing Object Status                            .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I CHECK_ITEM                    Checking New/Changed Components and Determining Addit. Data .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I DISPLAY_LOG                   Displaying Messages (For Example: Application Log)          .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I FILL_ADD_DATA                 Determining Addit.Data Before Displaying it on the Interface.
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I HANDLE_MESSAGES               Transfer of Contribution Class Messages                     .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I OKCODE                        Handling Own OK Codes                                       .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Data Is to Be Saved                                         .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I ON_F4_HELP                    ALV Event: Call F4 Help for a Field                         .
IF_RMSA_STD_DIA                I SELECT_STREAM                 Display Stream Selection Popup                              .
IF_RMSA_VAL                    I ON_NOTIFY_UPDATE              Process Parameters Were Changed                             .
IF_RMSA_VAL                    I READ_KEYDATA                  Read Key Data of Higher-Level Object                        .
IF_RMSA_VERS_RPC               I ON_NOTIFY_UPDATE              Object Changed                                              .
IF_RMSA_VERS_RPC               I READ_KEYDATA                  Read Key Data of Higher-Level Object                        .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I AENNR_CHECK                   Check Whether Change Number Exists                          .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I CHANGE_NR_REQUEST             Request Change Number                                       .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I CHANGE_VAL_ALLOW              Allow Changes to Validity Period                            .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I CHECK_CREATION                Check Object to Be Created                                  .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I CHECK_VALIDITY                Check Validity Period for New Objects                       .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I DYNPRO_FIELDS                 Read Fields for Screen 8010 from RMSA260                    .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I F4_HELP                       Call F4 Help                                                .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Get Instance                                                .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I REPLACE_ALLOW                 Allow Replacement for Data Records                          .
IF_RMSA_VRS_ATTRIB_GET         I SUBOBJECTS                    List of Allowed Subobject Types                             .
IF_RMST_ALV_DATA               I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Check Routine for Changes in ALV Grid                       .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I NEW_LINE                      RMS-TLS: Start of New Output Line                           .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I NEW_PAGE                      RMS-TLS: Start of New Page                                  .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I SKIP                          RMS-TLS: Output Blank Lines                                 .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I WRITE_FIELDS                  RMS-TLS: Output Several Objects in Individual Fields        .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I WRITE_LABEL                   RMS-TLS: Output Several Objects in Individual Fields        .
IF_RMST_OTPT                   I WRITE_TABLE                   RMS-TLS: Output Several Objects in a Table                  .
IF_RMST_PARAMETER_TREE         I CHANGE_ITEM                   Select/Deselect Nodes                                       .
IF_RMST_PARAMETER_TREE         I IS_ITEM_SELECT                Check: Is Node or End Node Selected?                        .
IF_RMST_PARAMETER_TREE         I READ_OLD_APPL_PARAM           Read Application Parameters (Saved Before RMS 2.2)          .
IF_RMST_PROT_PREPDISP          I GET_DESCR2LOG                 Text Field Retrieval                                        .
IF_RMST_PROT_PREPDISP          I GET_DESCR2MESS                Additional Information for Program Messages (Context)       .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I CHECK_APPLPARAM_CHANGED       Were Application Parameters Changed?                        .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I CHECK_APPL_PARAMS             Checks Whether Application Parameters Entered Are Plausible .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I GET_APPLPARAM_TYPE            Queries the Structure Category for the Application Params   .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I INIT                          One-Time Call When Screen Is Accessed                       .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_APPLPARAM_DEFAULT          Request for Default Application Parameters to Be Displayed  .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_EXIT_DYNPRO                One-Time Call When Screen Is Exited                         .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_FILTER_DDIC_DEF            Allows Certain Tree Items to Be Hidden                      .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_ITEM_CHANGED               Call When Node is Selected/Deselected                       .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_LAYOUT_LOAD                Call After Loading Layout                                   .
IF_RMST_SUBSCREEN_NOTIFY       I ON_LAYOUT_SAVE                Call Before Layout Is Saved                                 .
IF_RMWB_SRV                    I INIT                          Service Initialization                                      .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I ADD_OBJECT                    Add Object and Edge to Workbench                            .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I ASK_FOR_SAVE                  Popup (OK, Cancel) + Save All Objects                       .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I DELETE_EDGE                   Remove Edge                                                 .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object Everywhere                                    .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I EXPAND                        Expand Object                                               .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I GET_OKCODE                    Returns Current OK Code During PAI                          .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I GET_RUNTIME_INFO              Runtime Settings                                            .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I GET_SELECTED_DET_NODES        Gets Table for Selected Nodes (Detail Area)                 .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Gets Table for Selected Nodes                               .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I GET_WBO_FROM_WBOCAT           Determine Object                                            .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_ACTIVE_OBJECT             Set New Active Object                                       .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_CHANGED                   Mark Object As Changed                                      .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_HEADER_WBO                WBO Uses Tree Handler                                       .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_PAI_ERROR                 Error During PAI - Stop Event Handling                      .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I SET_TITLE                     Set Title                                                   .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I TOOGLE                        Switch Between Display "-" Change                           .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I UPDATE_OBJECT                 Update Node Including Lower-Level Node                      .
IF_RMWB_WB                     I UPDATE_TREE                   Update Tree After Change (During Input Help etc.)           .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I CONTEXT_MENU_REQUEST          Context Menu Extension                                      .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I DRAG                          Drag Event                                                  .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I DROP                          Drop Event                                                  .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I EXIT                          Exiting Workbench                                           .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I EXPAND                        Returns Dependent Objects of a UID                          .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I FOCUS_GET                     WBO Gets Focus for a Certain UID                            .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I FOCUS_LOST                    WBO Loses Focus                                             .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Gets Instance of a WBO                                      .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I GET_WBO_CONFIG_CL             Gets Configuration for WBO Type                             .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I KEYPRESS                      Function Keys Pressed (F1, F4...)                           .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I OKCODE                        OK-Code Handler                                             .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_RMWB_WBO                    I SHOW                          Representation of Icon and Columns of a UID                 .
IF_RMWB_WBO_TITLE              I SET_TITLE                     Set Title in Screen                                         .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I APPEND_CHILD                  Adds a Child to MT_CHILD                                    .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I DELETE_CHILDREN               Deletes Children from the MT_CHILD Table                    .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I GET_ALLOWED_CHILD_OBJ_TYP     Gets the Permitted Object Categories for Children           .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I GET_CHILDREN                  Determines the References of the Required Children          .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Gets the Object Category of the ROM Node                    .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_TXT           Gets the Language-Dependent Text for the Object Category    .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I GET_PARENT                    Gets the Reference to the Higher-Level Node                 .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I IS_LOWER                      Compares Own ID with ID of the Given Object                 .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I IS_VALID_CHILD                Checks Whether IO_CHILD Can Be Child of the Instance        .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I SET_PARENT                    Overwrites the Attribute M_PARENT                           .
IF_RMXM_ROM_OBJECT             I SORT_CHILDREN                 Sorts the MT_CHILD Table (Using IS_LOWER)                   .
IF_RMXM_ROM_TOOL               I ADJUST_MR_DATA                Adjust Data of Master Recipe Object                         .
IF_RMXM_ROM_TOOL               I EXPORT_TO_PPPI                Export PP-PI Structure                                      .
IF_RMXM_ROM_TOOL               I IMPORT_FROM_PPPI              Import Data from PP-PI Structure                            .
IF_RMXM_ROM_TOOL               I REASSIGN_KEY                  Reassign Key Values of Object                               .
IF_RMXM_ROM_TOOL               I TRANSFORM_GR2MR               Transformation of General Recipe Obj. to Master Recipe Obj. .
IF_RMXM_ROM_XML_IO             I EXPORT                        Export a Subtree                                            .
IF_RMXM_ROM_XML_IO             I IMPORT                        Import a Subtree to ROM Structure                           .
IF_RMXT_FRML_TOOL              I COPY_TRIAL_RCP                Copies a Trial/Recipe                                       .
IF_RMXT_FRML_TOOL              I GET_TRIAL_DATA                Transfers Trial(s) with Linked Recipe(s)                    .
IF_RMXT_FRML_TOOL              I MSG_INTO_LOG                  Puts API Messages in Application Log                        .
IF_RMXT_FRML_TOOL              I SET_ACTIVE_OBJECT             Sets Trial to Active (ONLY Relevant for Results View)       .
IF_RMXT_FRML_TOOL              I SET_CHANGED                   Register Recipes as Changed in Workbench                    .
IF_RMXT_GIS_IS_WBSERVICE       I BEFORE_PBO                    WB Service Communication with Service Screen (PBO)          .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I BUILD_ICON_QUICKINFO          Constructs Icon with Quick Info from Icon ID and Text       .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I CHECK_TASK_EXECUTION          Checks Whether a Task Can Be Executed                       .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I DISP_CONT_MENU                Generate Context Menu for a Task                            .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I EXECUTE_TASK                  Execute Task                                                .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I EXE_CONT_MENU                 Execute Context Menu Entry                                  .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I FREE                          Deletes All Data Within a Monitor Instance                  .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I FREE_CL                       Releases all Monitor Instances                              .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I GET_ALL_TASK                  Determines Table with All Tasks (+ Texts + Icons)           .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Determines a Monitor Instance                               .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I INIT                          Initialize Monitor Instance for a Trial                     .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I LOG_ADD_MSG                   Application Log: Add Message                                .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I LOG_SAVE                      Application Log: Save Messages in the Database              .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I LOG_SHOW                      Application Log: Display Messages                           .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I REFRESH                       Redetermines the Task Statuses                              .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR                I SET_STATUS                    Sets a System and/or User Status                            .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_SERVICE        I AUTHORITHY_CHECK              Authorziation Check for Execution of Tasks                  .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_SERVICE        I CHECK_TASK_EXECUTION          Central Checks Before Execution of Task                     .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_SERVICE        I GET_OBJNR_TABLE               Provides Monitor with Table of OBJNR - OBJTYP               .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_VIEW           I ASK_FOR_SAVE                  Request Surrounding Application to Save                     .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_VIEW           I CHECK_VIEW_ACTIVE             Check Whether the Monitor View Is Active                    .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_VIEW           I DELIVER_KEYDATA               Gets Object Key Data for the Display in the Monitor View    .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_VIEW           I REFRESH_APPL                  Refresh Surrounding Application                             .
IF_RMXT_MONITOR_VIEW           I REFRESH_OBJ                   Redisplay Object After Execution of Task                    .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Checks Authorizations                                       .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I CHECK_LINEMODE                Checks the Mode of a Table Row (Insert, Update, Delete)     .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I CHECK_NUMBER                  Checks External Number Against External Number Range        .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I COPY                          Copies a Building Block                                     .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I CREATE_NEW_QMBB_CL            Generate a New Building Block                               .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Always Determines a New Object Instance                     .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I GET_NEXT_NUMBER               Gets New Building Block Number from Number Range            .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I INIT                          Reset All Buffer Tables                                     .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I READ                          Reads All Data for a Building Block                         .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I SAVE                          Saves All Data for a Building Block                         .
IF_RMXT_QMBBOBJ                I WRITE                         Writes All Data for a Building Block                        .
IF_RMXT_TASK                   I EXECUTE_TASK                  Execute Task                                                .
IF_RMXT_TASK                   I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Gets a Task Instance                                        .
IF_RMXT_TASK                   I GET_TASK_ACTY                 Additional Checks for Task Activity                         .
IF_RMXT_TASK                   I GET_TASK_STAT                 Additional Checks for Task Status                           .
IF_RMXT_TASK_CTMENU            I DISP_CONT_MENU                Create Context Menu for Task                                .
IF_RMXT_TASK_CTMENU            I EXE_CONT_MENU                 Execute Context Menu Entry                                  .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I ADJUST_RELATIONS_WUL          Relationship Table for Higher and Lower-Level Trials        .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Checks Authorizations                                       .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Checks Consistency of the Objects Assigned to the Trial     .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I CHECK_DATA                    Checks Trial Data                                           .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I CHECK_LINEMODE                Checks the Mode of a Table Row (Insert, Update, Delete)     .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I CHECK_NUMBER                  Checks External Number Against External Number Range        .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I COPY                          Copies a Trial                                              .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I DELETE                        Prepares a Complete Trial for Deletion                      .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I DISPLAY_CHANGE_DOCUMENT       Displays the Change Document                                .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I GET_INSTANCE_CL               Always Determines a New Object Instance                     .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I GET_NEXT_NUMBER               Determines a New Trial Number from the Number Range         .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I GET_PLAN_STATUS               Derive Trial Planning Status                                .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I INIT                          Deletes the Trial Data from the Buffer                      .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I ON_CREATE                     Event After Creation of Object                              .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I READ                          Reads All Trial Data                                        .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I SAVE                          Saves All Trial Data                                        .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I SELECT_OBJECTS_FOR_COPY       Objects That Can Be Copied                                  .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I TRANSFER_LINEMODE             Sets the Mode of a Table Row                                .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I WRITE                         Writes All Trial Data to the Buffer                         .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I WRITE_CHANGE_DOCUMENT         Writes the Change Document to Trial Management              .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I WRITE_CLASSIFICATION          Writes Classification Data to the Buffer                    .
IF_RMXT_TRIALOBJ               I WRITE_DOC_OBJ                 Writes Document Data to the Buffer                          .
IF_ROLE_CA                     I CREATE_ROLE                   Create New Role                                             .
IF_ROLE_CA                     I DELETE_ROLE                   Create New Role                                             .
IF_ROLE_CA                     I LOAD_ROLES                    Load Roles from the Database                                .
IF_ROLE_CA                     I ROLES_OF_OBJECT_GET           Read Roles for Business Object                              .
IF_ROLE_CL                     I BUSINESS_REFERENCE_GET        Assign Persistent Business Reference                        .
IF_ROLE_CL                     I GET_MODEL                     Role Model                                                  .
IF_ROLE_CL                     I GET_ROLE_DATA                 Role Record                                                 .
IF_ROUTING_LOCAL_RUNTIME       I GET_RECEIVERS                 Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_ROUTING_LOCAL_RUNTIME       I RECEIVERS_EXIST               Do not use. See interface documentation                     .
IF_RPE_CONNECTION              I CONNECT                       Connect                                                     .
IF_RPE_CONNECTION              I DISCONNECT                    Disconnect                                                  .
IF_RPE_CONNECTION              I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_RPE_CONNECTION              I TO_STRING                     Connection Description as String                            .
IF_RPE_SYNCHRONIZE             I FLUSH                         Flush                                                       .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I CHANGE_DEFECTS                Change Defect                                               .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I CHANGE_DEFECTS_CONF           Change Defect from Confirmation (Without Confirmatn Profile).
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I CHECK_NOTIF_EXTENSIBLE        Can Items Be Added to Notification                          .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I CREATE_DEFECTS                Create Defect                                               .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I CREATE_DEFECTS_CONF           Create Defect from Confirmation (Without Confirmatn Profile).
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I DELETE_DEFECTS                Delete Defect                                               .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_CATALOG_PROFILE           Read Catalog Profile                                        .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_CREATED_KEYS              Access to Keys of Created Defect Records                    .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_DEFECTS                   (Read) Access to Defect                                     .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_DEFECT_CLASSES            Read Possible Defect Classes                                .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_DEFECT_FIELDS             Access to Field Information for Defects Recording           .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_INSTANCE                  (Read) Access to Instance                                   .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_NOTIF_TYPE_VIA_CONF       Determine Notification Type Based on Order Type             .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I GET_REPORT_TYPE               Access to Report Type                                       .
IF_RPLM_DEFECT_API             I SET_CONFIRMATION_PARAMETERS   Transfer Confirmation Parameter and Determine Instance      .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I ADD_DATA                      Add Data (Items, Causes, Actions)                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I ADD_LONGTEXT                  Add Long Text                                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CHANGE_HEADER_DATA            Change Notification Header                                  .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check Before Saving                                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CLEANUP_AFTER_COMMIT          Clean Up After Commit                                       .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CLOSE                         Complete notification                                       .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I COMPLETE_TASK                 Complete Task                                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CONVERT_BREAKDOWN_DURATION_EXTConvert Downtime to External Format                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CONVERT_BREAKDOWN_DURATION_INTConvert Downtime to External Format                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CREATE_CAUSES                 Create Causes                                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CREATE_ITEMS                  Create items                                                .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I CREATE_NOTIFICATION           Create Notification                                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I DELETE_ACTIVITIES             Delete Actions                                              .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I DELETE_CAUSES                 Delete Causes                                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I DELETE_ITEMS                  Delete Items                                                .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I DELETE_PARTNERS               Delete Partner(s)                                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_CAUSE_LONGTEXT            (Read) Access to Causes Long Text                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_CODEGR_FROM_CAT_PROF      Read Code Groups from Catalog Profile                       .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_DATA_COMPLETE             (Read) Access to Complete Notification Data                 .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_EDIT_MODE                 (Read) Access to Processing Mode                            .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_FINAL_QMNUM               Access to Final Number                                      .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_HEADER_LONGTEXT           Access to Header Long Text (Read)                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_INSTANCE                  (Read) Access to Instance                                   .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_ITEM_LONGTEXT             (Read) Access to Item Long Text                             .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_NOTIF_NO                  (Read) Access to Notification Number                        .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_NOTIF_TYPE                (Read) Access to Notification Type                          .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_PARTNER_CONTACT_PERSON    Access to Data of Partner Role "Contact Person"             .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_PARTNER_CUSTOMER          Access to Data of Partner Role "Customer"                   .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_PRIMARY_STATUS            (Read) Access to Leading Status                             .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I GET_STATUS_TEXTS              (Read) Access to Status Texts                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I HAS_CHANGES                   Was notification (incl. subobjects) changed?                .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Instance Attribute +IQS*                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Changeable Notification                                     .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I IS_NOTIF_TYPE_CHANGEABLE      Changeable Notification Type                                .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I MODIFY_ACTIVITIES             Change Activities                                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I MODIFY_CAUSES                 Change Causes                                               .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I MODIFY_DATA                   Add Data (Items, Causes, Actions)                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I MODIFY_ITEMS                  Change Items                                                .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_EDIT_MODE                 (Write) Access to Processing Mode                           .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_HEADER_LONGTEXT           (Write) Access to Header Long Text                          .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_IN_PROCESS                Set Notification in Process                                 .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_NOTIF_NO                  (Write) Access to Notification Number                       .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_NOTIF_TYPE                (Write) Access to Notification Type                         .
IF_RPLM_NOTIF_API              I SET_USER_STATUS_CHANGED       User Status Changed Externally                              .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I DELETEARCHIVLINKDOC           Deletion of an ArchiveLink Documents                        .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I GETARCHIVLINKDOCUMENTS        Supplies the ArchiveLink Documents                          .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I GETARCLINKMETA                Metadata for Documents                                      .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I GETCONNECTIONS                Object-Document Link                                        .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I GETNUMBEROFARCHIVLINKDOCS     Supplies the Number of ArchiveLink Documents                .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I READURL                       Reading URL                                                 .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I SELECT_ARC_OBJ_TYPE_TXT       Reads Short Texts for Document Types                        .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I SELECT_DOC_TYPE_FROM_MIME     Supplies the ArchiveLink Document Class for MIME Type       .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_ARCHIV_LINK       I UPLOADARCHIVLINKDOC           Loading an ArchiveLink Document                             .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_DMS               I GETDMSDOCUMENTS               Supplies the URLs for Displaying Originals                  .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_DMS               I RELOADBINARYSTREAM            Reload Binary Value of a Document                           .
IF_RPLM_QIMT_DOCUMENTOBJECTS   I GETOBJECTDOCUMENTS            Supplies the Document Info Records for the Documents        .
IF_RPLM_QI_GRAPHIC_CACHE       I GET_CONTEXT_DATA              Supplies Context Data for Graphic                           .
IF_RPLM_QI_GRAPHIC_CACHE       I GET_NAVI_TEXT                 Supplies the Text for the Navigator                         .
IF_RPLM_QI_GRAPHIC_CACHE       I HAS_CHANGED                   Has Graphic Data Changed?                                   .
IF_RPLM_QI_GRAPHIC_CACHE       I ONACTION                      Reaction of Graphic to Web Dynpro Action                    .
IF_RPLM_QI_MODEL_REC_RES_CACHE I LOCK                          Flags the Cache Object as Locked                            .
IF_RPLM_QI_MODEL_REC_RES_CACHE I LOCK_FAILED                   Flags the Cache Object as Unlockable                        .
IF_RPLM_QI_MODEL_REC_RES_CACHE I RECORD_RESULT                 Writes Cache Changes to API Layer                           .
IF_RPLM_QI_MODEL_REC_RES_CACHE I SAVE                          Register with Model to Save                                 .
IF_RPLM_QI_MODEL_REC_RES_CACHE I UNLOCK                        Cache Object Will Be Flagged as Not Locked                  .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I GET_CHAR_CONTEXT_DATA         Reads Characteristic Data to Web Dynpro Context             .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I GET_CONTEXT_DATA              Reads Current Context Data to Web Dynpro Context            .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I GET_EDIT_MODE                 Returns Write Mode                                          .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I HAS_CHANGED                   Has the Result Been Changed?                                .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I IS_ACTION_ALLOWED             Execution of Action Permitted?                              .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I REFRESH                       Data Is Read from the QIBP Buffer                           .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I SET_CHAR_CONTEXT_DATA         Sets Characteristic Table from Web Dynpro Context           .
IF_RPLM_QI_REC_RESULTS_CACHE   I SET_CONTEXT_DATA              Writes Context Data from Web Dynpro Context                 .
IF_RRHI_HIERARCHY_INTERATOR    I CLOSE                         Close Interator                                             .
IF_RRHI_HIERARCHY_INTERATOR    I GET_CHILD                     Provides a Lower-Level of the Current Objects               .
IF_RRHI_HIERARCHY_INTERATOR    I GET_PARENT                    Provides the Higher-Level Object of the Current Object      .
IF_RRHI_HIERARCHY_INTERATOR    I GET_SIBLING                   Returns the Siblings of the Current Object                  .
IF_RRHI_HIERARCHY_INTERATOR    I OPEN                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RRHI_MEMBERSID              I GET_NEW_LEAVES                Provides the Leaves That Are New                            .
IF_RRHI_MEMBERSID              I GET_NODESID                   Determines a Node - SID                                     .
IF_RRHI_VIRT_HIER              I CREATE                        Method for Creating an Instance                             .
IF_RRHI_VIRT_HIER              I GET_HIER                      Provides Hierarchy Description & Intervals                  .
IF_RRHI_VIRT_HIER              I GET_TEXTS                     Provides Texts for Nodes of Type "0HIER_NODE"               .
IF_RRHI_VIRT_HIER              I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Determines the Timestamp of Last Change                     .
IF_RRSI_LOCAL_SID_70           I SID_VAL_CONVERT               Conversion of SID to Characteristic Value                   .
IF_RRSI_LOCAL_SID_70           I VAL_SID_CONVERT               Converts Characteristic Value to SID                        .
IF_RSAN_IS_NODE_PACK           I GET_PACKAGE_SIZE              Get Package Size (Number of Records)                        .
IF_RSAN_IS_NODE_UI             I ON_MENU_REQUEST               Request Service Specific Menu Extension                     .
IF_RSAN_IS_NODE_UI             I ON_MENU_SELECTED              Handle Service Specific Menu Options                        .
IF_RSAN_MDL_DT_NODE            I GET_TARGET_KEY_FOR_ARUN       Get Target Object Key for Analysis Run                      .
IF_RSAN_MDL_LAYOUT_INFO        I SET_LAYOUT                    SET_LAYOUT                                                  .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_SOURCE     I GET_MAPPING_SOURCE_FIELDS     Get Fields for Mapping - Source View                        .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_SOURCE     I GET_MAX_NUMBER_OF_TARGETS     Maximum Number of Outgoing Mappings to Other Targets        .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_SOURCE     I GET_MIN_NUMBER_OF_TARGETS     Maximum Number of Outgoing Mappings to Other Targets        .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_SOURCE     I MAPPING_ADDED                 Notify node that mapping has been added to analysis         .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_SOURCE     I MAPPING_REMOVE                Notify node that a mapping will be deleted                  .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I GET_MAPPING_TARGET_FIELDS     Get Fields for Mapping - Target View                        .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I GET_MAX_NUMBER_OF_SOURCES     Maximum number of incoming mappings from other sources      .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I GET_MIN_NUMBER_OF_SOURCES     Maximum number of incoming mappings from other sources      .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I IS_SOURCE_STRUCTURE_INHERITED Flag: node inherits structure from source =" no mapping nec..
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I MAPPING_ADDED                 Notify node that mapping has been added to analysis         .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MAPPING_TARGET     I MAPPING_REMOVE                Notify node that a mapping will be deleted                  .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MR                 I CONVERT_SELTAB                Convert Filter on Target Fields to Filter on Source Fields  .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MR                 I GET_SOURCE_FIELDS             Get Source Fields of Mapping Rule                           .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MR                 I GET_TARGET_FIELDS             Get Target Fields of Mapping Rule                           .
IF_RSAN_MDL_MR                 I MAP                           Map Source Fields to Target Fields                          .
IF_RSAN_MDL_TASK               I EXECUTE                       Execute Task                                                .
IF_RSAN_OM_DOCUMENT            I NEW_ELEMENT                   Create a New Element that Can Be Added to this Document     .
IF_RSAN_OM_DOCUMENT            I SET_FACTORY                   SET_FACTORY                                                 .
IF_RSAN_OM_ELEMENT             I SET_DOCUMENT                  SET_DOCUMENT                                                .
IF_RSAN_OM_ELEMENT             I SET_NAME                      SET_NAME                                                    .
IF_RSAN_OM_ELEMENT             I SET_TEXT                      SET_TEXT                                                    .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I CLONE                         Make a Deep Copy of an Element                              .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I EDIT_POPUP                    Call ClassID-Dependent Dialog Box to Maintain Properties    .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I GET_CLASSID                   Get ClassID of object                                       .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I GET_CLASSID_FOR_XML_ELEMENT   Get ClassID for XML Element                                 .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I GET_CLASSINFO_FOR_ID          Get Class Metadata for ClassID                              .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I GET_CLASSINFO_FOR_REF         Get Class Metadata for Object Reference                     .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I NEW                           Create New Object for ClassID                               .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I XML_VERSION_GET               Get the Version. Will be Rendered as Namespace Value        .
IF_RSAN_OM_FACTORY             I XML_VERSION_UPGRADE           Convert a DOM from an Older Version to the Actual Version   .
IF_RSAN_RT_ABSTRACT            I FREE                          Release Resources                                           .
IF_RSAN_RT_ABSTRACT            I PREPARE                       Prepare Execution Plan of Runtime                           .
IF_RSAN_RT_ARUN_WRITE          I SET_TARGET_KEY                Set the Target Object Information in the Analysis Run Header.
IF_RSAN_RT_PROCESS             I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_RSAN_RT_ROUTINE_CONTEXT     I ADD_MESSAGE                   Add Message                                                 .
IF_RSAN_RT_SOURCE              I CLOSE                         CLOSE                                                       .
IF_RSAN_RT_SOURCE              I CREATE_DATA_TABLE             Create Internal Table (of Correct Type) Used in Get         .
IF_RSAN_RT_SOURCE              I FETCH                         FETCH                                                       .
IF_RSAN_RT_SOURCE              I OPEN                          OPEN                                                        .
IF_RSAN_RT_TARGET              I CLOSE                         CLOSE                                                       .
IF_RSAN_RT_TARGET              I CREATE_DATA_TABLE             Create Internal Table (of Correct Type) Used in Get         .
IF_RSAN_RT_TARGET              I OPEN                          OPEN                                                        .
IF_RSAN_RT_TARGET              I PUT                           PUT                                                         .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I CONVERT_TO_EXTERNAL           Converts Value to External Representation                   .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I CONVERT_TO_EXTERNAL_CLIKE     Converts Value to External Representation - Clike Params    .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I CONVERT_TO_INTERNAL           Converts Value to Internal Representation                   .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I CONVERT_TO_INTERNAL_CLIKE     Converts Value to Internal Representation - Clike Params    .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I CREATE_DATA_CONTAINER         Creates Correctly Typed Data Container (REF TO DATA)        .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I F1                            Provide F1 Help                                             .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I F4                            Provide F4 Help                                             .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I GET_ABAP_TYPE                 Get Type String That Can Be Used in Generated ABAPs         .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I GET_APD_TYPE                  Get old APD type description (tuple: infoobject, typename)  .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I GET_DB_TYPE                   Get (Fill) DD03P Structure Used When Generating DB          .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I GET_TYPE_DESCRIPTION          Retrieves Type String Representation - Parseable by Factory .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I IS_COMPATIBLE                 Comparison on ABAP Move Compatibility                       .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I IS_EQUAL                      Comparison on Type Objects Equality                         .
IF_RSAN_UT_TYPE                I IS_VALID                      Check If the Type Information Is Valid                      .
IF_RSAR_PSA_API                I AFTER_DELETE                  After Delete Activities                                     .
IF_RSAR_PSA_API                I DISPLAY_ERROR_LOG             Display log for errored record                              .
IF_RSAR_PSA_API                I GET_ERROR_RECORDS             Get list of error records                                   .
IF_RSAR_PSA_API                I SET_ERROR_RECORDS             Set error records                                           .
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I GET_ALL                       Returns All Objects (Possible Restriction to area, apco)    .
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I GET_BY_FOLDER                 Returns All Objects Under a Folder Node (AREA, APCO)        .
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I GET_ICON                      Returns Icon Independent of Object Status (Active, Inactive).
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I GET_RELATED                   get_related Access (Workaround for Slow Tlogo Methods       .
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I GET_SINGLE                    Returns the Properties Required in the DWB                  .
IF_RSAWBN_AWBOBJ               I SET_FOLDER                    Sets the Folder (InfoArea, Applnm) for a DWB Object         .
IF_RSAWBN_FOLDER_TREE          I CHANGE_NODE                   Change of Node (Text)                                       .
IF_RSAWBN_FOLDER_TREE          I CREATE_NODE                   Inserts a New Node                                          .
IF_RSAWBN_FOLDER_TREE          I DELETE_NODE                   Deletes Node                                                .
IF_RSAWBN_FOLDER_TREE          I GET_TREE                      Returns the Complete Sort Node Hierarchy                    .
IF_RSAWBN_FOLDER_TREE          I MOVE_NODE                     A Node Is Reassigned                                        .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I ADD_AWB_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS       Add AWB Button to a Toolbar Reference                       .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I NAVIGATE                      access an awb request to call another transaction           .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I PAI_DISPATCH                  process navigation events have to be called in dynpro pai   .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I PBO                           navigator pbo has to be called in dynpro pbo                .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I REFRESH                       Tree is being refreshed (after save, activate, call)        .
IF_RSAWBN_NAVIGATOR            I UNDOCK_CONTROLS               Remove controls from dynpro (call another dynpro)           .
IF_RSAWBN_STATUS               I IS_CLOSE_BUTTON_VISIBLE       Is Close Button Visible? (= false on Initial Screen of DWB) .
IF_RSAWBN_STATUS               I SET_CLOSE_BUTTON_VISIBLE      Sets Status of Close Button                                 .
IF_RSBATCH_CALLBACK            I SET_STATE                     Callback for Event 'Status Red' or 'Status Green'           .
IF_RSBC_ERROR_HANDLER          I GET_DTP                       Get DTP                                                     .
IF_RSBC_ERROR_HANDLER          I GET_SEMANTIC_GROUPS           Return Actual Grouping Key Selected                         .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I COPY_FROM_TEMPLATE            Copies Attributes of a Command Instance                     .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I CREATE_PROCESS_PARAMETERS     Before Parallel Processing: Output Runtime-Specific Param.  .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_CMD                       Command Identifier                                          .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_CMDTYPE                   Command Type                                                .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Context Menu for Log UI                                     .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_INTLEN_INBOUND            Width of Inbound Structure in Bytes                         .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_INTLEN_OUTBOUND           Width of Outbound Structure in Bytes                        .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_S_TLOGO                   Determine TLOGO Object                                      .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I GET_TEXT                      Command Description                                         .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I OPTIMIZE_COMMANDS             Request Optimization after Generation                       .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I SET_BREAKPOINTS               Setting Breakpoints                                         .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I SET_CTYPE                     Controller Type                                             .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I SET_DTPTYPE                   DTP Type                                                    .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I SET_PROCESS_PARAMETERS        After Parallel Processing: Setting Runtime-Specific Param.  .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I SET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation                                       .
IF_RSBK_CMD                    I USER_COMMAND                  User Command from Log UI                                    .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I GET_DATAPACKAGE               Gets a Data Package                                         .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I GET_DATAPACKAGE_GENERAL       Gets a Data Package (All Extraction Types)                  .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I GET_DATAPACKAGE_SEMGROUP      Gets a Semantically Complete Data Package                   .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I GET_MAXROWS                   Returns Maximum Number of Rows To Be Read                   .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I GET_T_FIELDS_SEL              Fields Available for Selection                              .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I SET_GROUPS_EXIST              Set Indicator: Groups Exist                                 .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I SET_MAXROWS                   Maximum Number of Rows To Be Read                           .
IF_RSBK_CMD_X                  I SET_SEMANTIC_GROUPS           Sets Semantic Groups                                        .
IF_RSBK_DATAPACKAGE_OBSERVER   I ENQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Lock Status Tables                                          .
IF_RSBK_DEBUG                  I GET_BREAKPOINTS               Determines Breakpoint                                       .
IF_RSBK_DEBUG                  I SET_BREAKPOINT                Sets Breakpoint                                             .
IF_RSBK_DELTA_SERVER           I GET_PROCESSEDALL              Returns Pointer to Largest of All Fetched Request IDs       .
IF_RSBK_DELTA_SERVER           I GET_PROCESSEDONE              Returns Pointer to Largest of At Least One Fetched Req. ID  .
IF_RSBK_DELTA_SERVER           I GET_REQUESTS                  Delivers List of Requests on the Server                     .
IF_RSBK_DELTA_SERVER           I SET_PROCESSEDALL              Sets Pointer to Largest Request ID Fetched                  .
IF_RSBK_DELTA_SERVER           I SET_PROCESSEDONE              Pointer to Largest Request ID with at Least One Recipient   .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I CLEAR_DATA                    Deletes All Data in the INDX Table                          .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_BATCH_PROCESS             Number of Last Background Process                           .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_DATA                      Reads a Data Package from a INDX Table                      .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_LAST                      Returns 'Last Package in Request' Indicator                 .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_LAST_STEP_BUF             Last Step with Temporary Storage                            .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_LINES_READ                Number of Data Records Transferred from Extractor           .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_LINES_TRANSFERRED         Number of Data Records Transferred to Target                .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I GET_T_DATAINFO                Information About Temporary Storage                         .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I SET_BATCH_PROCESS             Number of Current Background Process                        .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I SET_DATA                      Writes a Data Package to an INDX Table, If Necessary        .
IF_RSBK_DP                     I SET_LAST                      Sets 'Last Package in Request' Indicator                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I EXISTS_ON_DB                  Checks Existence of DTPs on the Database                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I FREE                          Release Memory                                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I FREE_GUI_ATTRIBUTES           Delete UI Relevant Attributes                               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_ACTIVFL                   M Version = A Version?                                      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_ACTUAL_REQUEST            Reference to last request loaded which has not been deleted .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_ALL_TEXTS                 Text Table                                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_AUTOQUALOK                Indicator: Set USTATE Automatically Using TSTATE            .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_BATCH_OK                  Indicator: Execution in Background OK                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_CMD_U                     Update Command                                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_CMD_X                     Extraction Command                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_CONTREL                   Content Release                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_CONTTIMESTMP              Content time stamp                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DELTA                     Delta Method                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DELTAONLYONCE             Indicator: Transfer Delta Only Once                         .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DELTASTAT                 Delta Status                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DISPLAY_MODE              Display mode                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DREQSER                   BW delta process: Serialization request                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTP                       DTP ID                                                      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTPE                      Error DTP                                                   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTPTYPE                   Type of DTP                                                 .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTP_EQUIVALENT_FOR_LOGSYS Equivalent DTP for a Particular Source System               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTP_ORIGINAL              Original DTP (Transport)                                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTP_SHADOW                Associated DTP in Delivery                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DTP_STANDARD              Associated Standard DTP                                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_DVERSKEY                  Key of Associated D Version                                 .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_ERRORHANDLING             Type of Error Handling                                      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_GROUPFIELDS               Grouping Fields for Extraction                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_GROUPS_EXIST              Indicator: Grouping Necessary                               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_GROUP_PREIMAGE            Intersection of Original Screens of All Grouping Fields     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_ISSAVED                   Save status                                                 .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_KEY_PREIMAGE              Intersection of Original Screens of Target Key              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_LOGSYS                    Logical System (If System-Dependent)                        .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_MAXSIZE                   Package Size                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_NOAGGR                    DTP Error Handling: Aggregation Not Permitted               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_NON_COMMUTATIVE           Indicator: Non-Commutative Update of Field Content          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_NUMBER_AT_ERR             No. of records to be checked when handling incorrect data   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJSTAT                   Object Status                                               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJVERS                   Object Version (General)                                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_DTP_ERROR         Object Reference to Error DTP                               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_DTP_STANDARD      Object Reference to Associated Standard DTP                 .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_ERROR_HANDLER     Object Reference to Error Handler                           .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_FILTER            Object Reference to Filter                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_SRC               Object Reference to Data Source                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_SRC_LAST          Last Substep Before Update                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_TGT               Object Reference to Data Target                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_TGT_FIRST         Object Reference to First Data Recipient After Extraction   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_TPL_U             Object Reference to Update Command Template                 .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBJ_REF_TPL_X             Object Reference to Extraction Command Template             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OBSERVER                  Observer of Request Generated by This DTP                   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_OWNER                     Person Responsible (Content)                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_PROCESSMODE               Processing Mode (Parallel/Serial)                           .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_PROCESSMODES_FOR_F4       Supported Processing Modes                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_RDASTATUS                 Real-Time Status                                            .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_REALTIME_SUPPORTED        Indicator: DTP Supports Real Time                           .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_RECEIVE_DATA_FROM         Determines Dependent Objects                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_RELATED_DEPENDENT         Determines Dependent Objects                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_RELATED_EXISTENTIAL       Determines Existing Dependent Objects                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_RELATED_USED              Determines Objects Used by the DTP                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_REMOTE_SUPPORTED          Indicator: DTP Supports Direct Access                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SEND_DATA_TO              Determines Dependent Objects                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SERIALIZED                Indicator: Serialized Update                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation                                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SINGLEREQUEST             Indicator: Get Data by Request                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SRC                       Data Source ID and Type                                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SRCNM                     Source ID                                                   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_SRCTP                     Type of Source                                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_S_BUFFER                  Settings To Be Deleted from Temporary Memory                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_S_TADIR                   Entry in Object Catalog                                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TEXT                      DTP Description                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TEXT_DEFAULT              Standard DTP Description                                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TGT                       Data Target ID and Type                                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TGTNM                     Target ID                                                   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TGTTP                     Type of Target                                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TH_RANGE                  Selections of DTP                                           .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TH_REQUID_SRC_NEW         Source Requests Not Yet Read                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TH_TPL                    List of Command Templates                                   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TIMESTMP                  Time Stamp                                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_TSTPNM                    Last Changed By                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_T_DEFAULT_CHAIN           Delivers Default Chain                                      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_T_FIELDS_SRC_KEYOPT       Possible Grouping Fields for Extraction                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_T_INFO_FNAM               Unexpected Info Table for Process Chains                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_T_ISOURCE                 DTP InfoSources                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_T_TRANSFORMATION          Transformations in DTP                                      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_UPDMODE                   Extraction Mode                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_DISPLAY            I GET_WARNINGTSTATE             Technical Status with Warnings in Log                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_EXECUTE            I CREATE_REQUEST                Generate a Request                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_EXECUTE            I READ_DATA                     Call for Direct Access, Does Not Work for REMOTE-DTPs!      .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I CHECK_SRC_TGT                 Checks Source and Target and Connection Between Them        .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I CREATE_DEFAULT_PC_VARIANTS    Generates Default Process Variants (such as Activate DSO)   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I ON_SRC_CHANGED                Impact: Source Object Changed                               .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_AUTOQUALOK                Automatic Revaluation of Overall Status                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_DELTAONLYONCE             Indicator: Get Delta Only Once                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_DTPTEXT                   Changes Description of DTP                                  .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_DTPTYPE                   Set DTP Type                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_DTP_ORIGINAL              Set Original DTP                                            .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_ERRORHANDLING             Error Handling Mode                                         .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_LOGSYS                    Set Logical System                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_MAXSIZE                   Package Size                                                .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_NUMBER_AT_ERR             Error tolerance                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_OBJSTAT                   Sets Object Status (Can Be Executed / Cannot Be Executed)   .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_RDASTATUS                 Real-Time Status                                            .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation                                       .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_SINGLEREQUEST             Indicator: Get Data by Request                              .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_SRC                       Change Data Source                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_S_BUFFER                  Set Settings to Delete Temporary Storage                    .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_S_TADIR                   Entry in Object Catalog                                     .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_TGT                       Change Data Target                                          .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_UPDMODE                   Extraction Mode                                             .
IF_RSBK_DTP_MAINTAIN           I SET_WARNINGTSTATE             Technical Status with Warnings in Log                       .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I CHECK_TSTATE                  Determines Technical Status (More Detailed Check)           .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I CREATE                        Generate Request                                            .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I CREATE_DATAPACKAGE            Gernerate a New Data Package with Status READY              .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I DELETE                        Delete Request                                              .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I DOIT                          Execution of Request (Only If USTATE = READY)               .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_ALL_PROCESS_STEPS         Deliver All Necessary Procesing Steps (GUI)                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_ANALYZED                  Indicator: Request Has Already Been Analyzed                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_BATCHID                   Batch ID for a Specific Request Run                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_BUFFER_EXIST              Checks Whether Buffers Exist                                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_CTYPE                     Deliver Controller Type                                     .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DELETABLE                 Indicator: Can Be Deleted                                   .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DELTAONLYONCE             Indicator: Transfer Delta Only Once                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DELTA_REQUESTS            Deliver Source Request                                      .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DTP                       Deliver DTP ID                                              .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DTPTEXT                   DTP Description                                             .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_DTPTYPE                   Type of Generating DTP                                      .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_ERRORHANDLING             Error Handling Category                                     .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_HOLD_PAR_PROCS            Indicator: Keep Parallel Processes Open                     .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_LINES_READ                Number of records read                                      .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_LINES_TRANSFERRED         Number of records transferred to data target                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_LOG                       Reference to Log                                            .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_LOGID_PC                  Log ID of Associated Process Chain                          .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_LOGSYS_SRC                ID of Source System                                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_MAXSIZE                   Deliver Package Size                                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_NO_MONITOR                Indicator: Monitor Off                                      .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_NUMBER_AT_ERR             Maximum Number of Incorrect Records                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_CMD               Deliver Reference to Command                                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_CMD_ERRH          Delivers Reference to Error Handler Command                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_DP                Reference to Specific Data Package                          .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_DTP_H             Reference to Historic DTP Version                           .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_ERRH              Get Error Handler (If Instantiated)                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_SRC               Source Object                                               .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_SRC_LAST          Delivers Source/Transformation Indirectly Before Update     .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_OBJ_REF_TGT               Target object                                               .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_PARALLEL_PROCS            Number of Related Processes to Be Processed                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_PROCESSMODE               Processing mode                                             .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_REALTIME                  Indicator: Real-Time Request                                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_REPAIRABLE                Returns Indicator: Request Repairable                       .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_REQUID                    Deliver Request SID                                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_REQUID30                  Request GUID                                                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_RUNID                     Counter for Request Runs                                    .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_SEVERITY                  Indicator: Deletable                                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation Request                               .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_SRC                       Deliver Source of Request                                   .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_SRCTP                     Deliver Source Type                                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_S_BUFFER                  Temporary Storage Settings                                  .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TGT                       Deliver Target of Request                                   .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TGTTP                     Deliver Target Type                                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TH_CMD_R                  Command List                                                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TH_DP_R                   List of Data Packages                                       .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TH_RANGE                  Deliver List of Restrictions for Extraction                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TH_REQUID_TGT             Returns Requests Containing Requests                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TH_RUN                    List of Request Runs                                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TRANSFERRED               Indicator: Request Status is or was 'green'                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TSTATE                    Deliver Technical Status                                    .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TSTMP_FINISH              Deliver Time Stamp                                          .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_TSTMP_START               Deliver Time Stamp of Last Change                           .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_T_DATAINFO                Information About Temporary Storage                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_T_ISOURCE                 InfoSources                                                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_T_JOBS                    Jobs in which the request is/was processed                  .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_T_STEPID                  Flat, Sorted List of Commands                               .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_UNAME                     Deliver User That Set Request to 'READY'                    .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_UPDMODE                   Deliver Extraction Mode                                     .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_USTATE                    User status                                                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I GET_WARNINGSTATE              Technical Status in Warnings in Log                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I RESUME                        Restart of an Erroneous Request                             .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_ANALYZED                  Indicator: Request Has Already Been Analyzed                .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_CTYPE                     Set Controller Type                                         .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_REQUID_SRC_RT             Sets Real-Time Request                                      .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_SEVERITY                  Indicator: Deletable                                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_STATE_DELETED_ALWAYS      Setzs Status to 'Deleted' Without Running Checks            .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_TSTATE                    Set Technical Status to 'Green'                             .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_USTATE_GREEN              Set User Status to 'Green'                                  .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_USTATE_RED                Set User Status to 'Red'                                    .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST                I SET_USTATE_YELLOW             Set User Status to 'Yellow'                                 .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_OBSERVER       I ENQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Lock Status Tables                                          .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I GET_LAST_DATAPACKAGE          Pointer to Last Green Data Package in Request Server        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I GET_PROCESSED_ALL             Deliver Pointer to All Read Requests                        .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I GET_PROCESSED_ONE             Deliver Pointer to a Request Read by at Least One Recipient .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I GET_REQUESTS                  Returns Sorted List of Included Requests                    .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I SET_REQUEST_STATE_DELETED_ALL Sets All Requests to 'Deleted'                              .
IF_RSBK_REQUEST_SERVER         I SET_SEVERITY                  Indicator: Requests Deletable                               .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I GET_ICON                      Icon of the Server                                          .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I GET_TEXT                      Returns Text                                                .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I GET_TLOGO                     TLOGO Type of Server                                        .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I GET_TLOGO_SUBTYPE             TLOGO Subtype                                               .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I IS_ACTIVE                     Checks whether the Server is Active                         .
IF_RSBK_SERVER                 I PICK                          Jump to Maintenance                                         .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_DATAPACKAGE_OBSERVER      Returns Data Package Observer for Source                    .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_DELTA                     Returns Delta Process for the Data Source                   .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_DTA_TYPE                  Returns Data Target Type                                    .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_LOGSYS                    Logical System for Source                                   .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_NAME                      Actual Name of Source (Part of ID)                          .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_NO_OPEN_HUB               Is open hub deactivated as target?                          .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_REMOTE_ENABLED            Indicator: Direct Access Possible                           .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_REQUEST_OBSERVER          Returns Request Observer for Source                         .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_SEND_DATA_TO              Returns Data Targets for this Data Source                   .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_SRC                       Data source ID                                              .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_SRCTP                     Type of Data Source                                         .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_STOCKUPD                  Indicator: Initial Non-Cumulative Build Is Supported        .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_SUPPORTS_REALTIME         Real Time Is Supported                                      .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_TGT_INVALID               Target allowed?                                             .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_TIMESTMP_ACT              Activation Time Stamp for Source                            .
IF_RSBK_SRC                    I GET_T_INFO_FNAM               Unexpected Info Format for Process Chains                   .
IF_RSBK_SRC_LAST               I GET_T_UPDINFO                 Information on Updated InfoObjects                          .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I CHECK_REQUESTS_EXIST          Deletes Requests That Already Exist from List               .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I DELETE_REQUEST                Deletes Request from Target                                 .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_DATAPACKAGE_OBSERVER      Returns Observer That Is Called with Status Changes         .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_REALTIME                  Real-Time Enabled (Can Be Loaded Using Daemon)?             .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_RECEIVE_DATA_FROM         All Data Sources Connected to this Data Target              .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_REMOTEPROVIDER            Indicator: Target Is RemoteProvider                         .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_REQUEST_OBSERVER          Returns Observer That Is Called with Status Changes         .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_SERIALIZED                Target Requires Serialized Data (MOVE Updating)             .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_SRC_INVALID               Indicator: Source Allowed                                   .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_STANDARDPROVIDER          Target Controls Standard Updates                            .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_STOCKUPD                  Indicator: Permitted as Target for Non-Cumulatives          .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_TGT                       ID of the Data Target                                       .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I GET_TGTTP                     Data Target Type                                            .
IF_RSBK_TGT                    I PARALLEL_UPDATE               Parallel Writing Permitted ?                                .
IF_RSBK_TGT_FIRST              I GET_OBJ_REF_INBOUND           Returns Inbound Format of the Data Recipient                .
IF_RSBK_TPL_MANDATORY          I GET_OBJ_REF_CMD               Delivers Object Reference to Command Instance               .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I AFTER_ACTIVATION              Actions After DDIC Activation(Before Activtng Table Entries).
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I AFTER_DELETION                Actions After Deletion of Sources                           .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I BEFORE_DELETION               Actions Before Deletion in DDIC                             .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I COPY_LOCAL_ATTRIBUTES         Transfers Local Properties from Template (After Import)     .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I GET_BATCH_OK                  Indicator: Execution in Background is OK                    .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I GET_DDIC_OBJECTS              Return Affected DDIC Objects (and Save Where Necessary)     .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I GET_DTPTYPE                   Indicator: DTP Type                                         .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I GET_PERSIST_DATA              Read the Temporary Storage Indicator                        .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I GET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation                                       .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I MERGE_VERSION                 Merge of Old DTP Versions                                   .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I ON_SRC_CHANGED                Impact Analysis: Source Object Changed                      .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I ON_TGT_CHANGED                Impact Analysis: Target Object Changed                      .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I ON_TRFN_CHANGED               Impact Analysis: Transformation Changed                     .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I SET_DTPTYPE                   Set DTP Type                                                .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I SET_LOGSYS                    Set Logical System                                          .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I SET_PERSIST_DATA              Sets Indicator: Save Data in Temporary Storage              .
IF_RSBK_TPL_OPTIONAL           I SET_SIMULATION                Indicator: Simulation                                       .
IF_RSBM_EXCEPTION_LOG          I GET_TEXT                      Text for GUI                                                .
IF_RSBM_EXCEPTION_LOG          I GET_TH_PAR                    Reads List of Field Value Pairs of an Exception Class       .
IF_RSBM_EXCEPTION_LOG          I SET_TH_PAR                    Sets List of Field Value Pairs of an Exception Class        .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I CONTEXT_MENU_EXECUTE          Execution of a Context Menu Command                         .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I CREATE_CHILD_FOR_GUI          Generates Subordinate Nodes Acc. to List of Expected Nodes  .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I CREATE_NEXT_FOR_GUI           Genertes NEXT Nodes Acc. to List of Expected Nodes          .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I EXPAND_FOR_BASIC_VIEW         Expands for Initial Display                                 .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I FREE                          Frees Memory                                                .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_CHILD                     Returns Subordinate Nodes (If Expanded)                     .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Returns Context Menu for Tree Control                       .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_DATE                      Reads Date of Node                                          .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_EXPANDED                  Indicator: Expanded                                         .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_IMAGE                     Returns Icon                                                .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_LOGID                     Returns Log ID                                              .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_NEXT                      Returns Next Node                                           .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_NODE                      Returns Node ID                                             .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_NODETYPE                  Node type                                                   .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_PARENT                    Returns Higher-Level Node                                   .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_RELATSHIP_TO_PARENT       Type of Connection to Relative Node                         .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_SHOW_MSG_BUTTON           Display of Button in Log Node                               .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_TEXT                      Returns Text for GUI                                        .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_TIME                      Returns Time of Node                                        .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_TSTMP_FROM                Start of Validity Interval                                  .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_TSTMP_TO                  End of Validity Interval                                    .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_T_MSG                     List of messages                                            .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I GET_T_MSG_RECU                List of Messages (Recursive for All Child Nodes)            .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I HAS_CHILDREN                  Indicator: Has Lower-Level Nodes                            .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I SET_EXPAND                    Sets Indicator: Expanded                                    .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_GUI           I USER_COMMAND                  OK Code Handler                                             .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_CHILD                     Attaches a Lower-Level Node to the Log                      .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_EXCEPTION                 Attaches Messages for an Exception Instance to the Log      .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_MSG                       Attaches Message to Log                                     .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_NEXT                      Attaches a Next Node to the Log                             .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_SY_MSG                    Adds Message to Log                                         .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_S_PAR                     Adds a Field/Value Row to the Log                           .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I ADD_T_MSG                     Attaches Table with Messages to Log                         .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I CONDENSE                      Compresses Node into a Hashed Node                          .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I FREE                          Frees Memory                                                .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I FREE_CHILDREN                 Frees Memory from Lower-Level Node                          .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_CHILD                     Object Reference to Lower-Level Node                        .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_LOGID                     Log Identifier                                              .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_MAXSTATE                  Maximum Status of All Messages Below                        .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_NEXT                      Object Reference to Next Node                               .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_NODETYPE                  Node type                                                   .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_PARENT                    Object Reference to Higher-Level Node                       .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I GET_T_STATDTP                 Node Attributes                                             .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I INVALIDATE                    Invalidates Node (Sets End Time Stamp)                      .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I INVALIDATE_NEXT               Invalidates Subsequent Nodes                                .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I INVALIDATE_NODE_ATTRIBUTES    Invalidated Node Attributes                                 .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_RUNTIME       I PERSIST                       Writes Node Attribute to the DB                             .
IF_RSBM_LOG_COMP_STATIC        I CREATE_FROM_DB                Generates an Instance of the Database                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_CHARACTERISTIC_BASE I SET_HIERARCHY                 Set Hierarchy                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I CONTAINS_CHANGED_DATA         Includes Changed Data                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I EXECUTE                       Execute Command                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I GET_OLAP_AREA                 Procure Olap Area                                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I REFRESH                       Check Whether There Is New Data                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I RESET                         Reset Changed Data for the Area                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_AREA           I SAVE                          Save Changed Data for the Area                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_PROVIDER       I DATA_OUT_OF_SYNC              Data Basis Has Changed for Data Provider                    .
IF_RSBOLAP_DATA_PROVIDER       I GET_TYPE                      Type of Data Provider                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_CHILDREN                  Get Child Nodes                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_CABILITIES  Get Capabilities of Member Access                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_NODE                      Get Node Details                                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_PARENT                    Get Parent Node                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_PARENT_SID                Get Parent SID                                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_ROOTS_WITH_CHILDREN       Get Root and Child Nodes to Start Level                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I GET_TEXTS                     Get Texts                                                   .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I SEARCH                        Find nodes                                                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I SET_HIERARCHY                 Set Hierarchy                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_HIERARCHY_BASE      I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_OBJECT              I FREE                          Release object                                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_OBJECT              I TO_ABAP_LIST                  Debug Info Output in an ABAP List                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_OBJECT              I TO_STRING                     Return Debug Info as Text                                   .
IF_RSBOLAP_OBJECT_VARIABLE     I GET_VALUES                    Procure Values for Object Variables                         .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I GET_COLUMNS_AXIS              Get Column Axis                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I GET_DATA_CELL_DETAILS         Get Data Cell Details                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I GET_FREE_AXIS                 Get Free Axis                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I GET_RESULT_SET                Get Result Set                                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I GET_ROWS_AXIS                 Get Row Axis                                                .
IF_RSBOLAP_QUERY_VIEW          I SET_INPUT_ENABLED             Set as Ready for Input                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_AXIS             I GET_CHARACTERISTICS           Return Characteristics of the Axis                          .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_AXIS             I GET_NAME                      Return Name of the Axis                                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_AXIS             I SET_CHARACTERISTICS           Set Characteristics of the Axis                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHARACTERISTIC   I GET_AXIS                      Axis on Which the Characteristic Is Located                 .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHARACTERISTIC   I GET_AXIS_NAME                 Get Axis Name                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHARACTERISTIC   I GET_RESULT_SET_PRESENTATION   Current Displays for the Result Set                         .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHARACTERISTIC   I SET_RESULT_SET_PRESENTATION   Displays to Be Requested for the Result Set                 .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHAR_INTERNAL    I PREPARE_FOR_READ              Perform Preparations for Reading                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_CHAR_INTERNAL    I SET_AXIS                      Find Out About Axis Affiliation                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_QV_SORTABLE         I GET_SORTING                   Get OLAP Sorting                                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_CHARACTERISTICS           Query Characteristic List                                   .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_EFFECTIVE_SELECTION       Query Section from Selection Space and Selection Status     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_NEW_SELECTION             Return New Selection for This Selection Object              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_SELECTION_SPACE           Query Selection Space                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_SELECTION_STATE           Query Selection Status                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I GET_SO_CHARACTERISTIC         Request Characteristic                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I INITIALIZE_VARIABLE_HANDLER   Generate and Initialize Variable Processor                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I RRI                           Report-Report Interface Jump                                .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR            I SET_DEFAULT_HIERARCHY_SETTINGSUse Hierarchy Settings for the Selection Object             .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_CHARACTERISTIC            Request Characteristic                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_CHARACTERISTICS           Query Characteristic List                                   .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_DESIGN_TIME_INFO          Information Before Variable Processing                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_NEW_SELECTION             Return New Selection for This Selection Object              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_RRI_RECEIVERS             Read Report to Report Receiver                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_SELECTION_SPACE           Query Selection Space                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_BASE       I GET_SELECTION_STATE           Query Selection Status                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_INTERNAL   I NOTIFY_CHARACTERISTIC_SETTINGSCommunicate Characteristic Settings of Environment          .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_INTERNAL   I NOTIFY_MASTER_DATA_READER     Communicate Master Data Reader                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SELECTOR_INTERNAL   I SET_STATE                     Set Complex Status                                          .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_ATTR_CONTAINER   I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Request Attributes                                          .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_ATTR_CONTAINER   I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_ATTRIBUTES  Procure Attributes for the Master Data Access               .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_ATTR_CONTAINER   I GET_SO_ATTRIBUTE              Request Attribute                                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_ATTR_CONTAINER   I SET_MEMBER_ACCESS_ATTRIBUTES  Set Attributes for Master Data Access                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHARACTERISTIC   I GET_MEMBERS                   Query Attribute Values                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHARACTERISTIC   I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_CABILITIES  Get Capabilities of Member Access                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHARACTERISTIC   I SET_HIERARCHY                 Set Hierarchy                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHAR_INTERNAL    I SELECTION_EXTERNAL_TO_SELDR   Converts a Complete Selection from External to Internal     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHAR_INTERNAL    I SELECTION_SELDR_TO_EXTERNAL   Converts a Complete Selection from Internal to External     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHAR_INTERNAL    I SET_STATE                     Change State                                                .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_CHAR_INTERNAL    I VALIDATE_SELDR                Check Seldr                                                 .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_INTERSECTION     I GET_INTERSECTION_TYPE         Determine Type of Intersection                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBERS                   Query Attribute Values                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_CABILITIES  Get Capabilities of Member Access                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_MODE        Procure Access Mode for Values                              .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_PRESENTATIONCurrent Displays for the Value Request                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBER_ACCESS_SORTING     Procure Sorting for Member Access                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I GET_MEMBER_PRESENTATIONS      Get Displays for Characteristic                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I SET_MEMBER_ACCESS_MODE        Set Access Mode for Values                                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_PRESENTABLE      I SET_MEMBER_ACCESS_PRESENTATIONSet Displys to Be Requested for Values                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I CONTAINS_NODE_SELECTION       Node selection available for characteristic?                .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I CONTAINS_SELECTION            Does Selection Exist for a Characteristic?                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I FREE                          Release Resources                                           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I GET_CARTESIAN_PRODUCT         Return Selection as Cartesian Product                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I GET_SELDR                     Return Selection as Seldr (BW Internal Use Only)            .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I GET_SELECTION_TYPE            Get Selection Type for a Characteristic                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I GET_VALIDATION_RESULT         Get Result of Validation                                    .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I INTERSECT                     Intersection of the Selection with Another Selection        .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I IS_ALL                        Selection Includes Everything                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I IS_CARTESIAN_PRODUCT          Selection Is a Cartesian Product                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Selection Is Changeable                                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I IS_EMPTY                      Empty Quantity Selected                                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I ONLY_SINGLE_MEMBERS_NO_NODES  Contains Single Values Only (No Nodes)                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I SET_CARTESIAN_PRODUCT         Set Selection as Cartesian Product                          .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I SET_SELDR                     Set Selection Using the Seldr (BW internal use only)        .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_SELECTION        I TO_STRING                     Output as String                                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_STATE_INTERNAL   I PREPARE_OLAP_STATE            Set Olap Status                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_STATE_INTERNAL   I PREPARE_OLAP_STATE_IMPL       Set Olap Status                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_STATE_INTERNAL   I SET_CHANGED_STATE             Set Status to Changed So That It Is Checked Later           .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_STATE_INTERNAL   I VALIDATE_STATE                Check Status                                                .
IF_RSBOLAP_SO_STATE_INTERNAL   I VALIDATE_STATE_IMPL           Validate Status                                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_SUPPORTS_VALIDATION I VALIDATE                      Check Access                                                .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE            I ADD_INFORMATION               Enhance Definition and Status Data                          .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE            I APPLY_PERSONALIZATION         Apply Personalization                                       .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE            I REMOVE_PERSONALIZATION        Remove Personalization                                      .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE            I SAVE_PERSONALIZATION          Save Personalization                                        .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE            I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I ADD                           Add Variables                                               .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I GET_DEFINITION                Procure Definition of Variables                             .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I GET_NODE_VARIABLE_HIERARCHIES Hierarchies for Hierarchy Node Variables                    .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I GET_OBJECT_VARIABLE_VALUES    Procure Values for Object Variables                         .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I GET_STATE                     Procure Status of Variables                                 .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I PERSONALIZATION_COMMAND       Personalization Command                                     .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I REMOVE                        Remove Variables                                            .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I SET_STATE                     Set Variable Status                                         .
IF_RSBOLAP_VARIABLE_CONTAINER  I SUBMIT                        Process Variable Values                                     .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I CALL_DATA_NOTIFY              Calls Notification After Data Extraction                    .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I CALL_DELETE_NOTIFY            Calls Notification After Data Extraction                    .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I CALL_META_NOTIFY              Calls Notification After Data Extraction                    .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I CHECK_TYPE_ALLOWED            Checks Whether Destination Type is Permitted in System      .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I GET_GUI                       Returns GUI                                                 .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I GET_INFO                      Returns Info for Processing                                 .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I GET_REFERENCE                 Delivers Reference to Interface                             .
IF_RSB_OHD_ENH                 I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets Parameter Table                                        .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_SERVER         I BEFORE_EXTRACTION             Method before Extraction                                    .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_SERVER         I F4                            List of all Open Hub Servers                                .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_SERVER         I GET_INFO                      Determines Metadata for DataSource                          .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_SERVER         I READ_DATA                     Method for Extracting Data                                  .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I AFTER_EXTRACTION              Signal: Process in Target System Complete                   .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I BEFORE_EXTRACTION             Current Status of the Client                                .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Checks for Existence of a Data Target                       .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I RECEIVE_DATA                  Receive Data                                                .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I REQUEST_ROLLBACK              Request: Incorrect Situation                                .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I SET_USTATE_GREEN              Overall Status of Request Is Green                          .
IF_RSB_OPEN_HUB_TARGET         I SET_USTATE_RED                Overall Status of Request Is Red                            .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I ACTIVATE                      Activates Delta Update                                      .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I CHECK_STATUS                  Check and Set Delta Status                                  .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivates Delta Update                                    .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I GET_REQUESTS                  Delivers Current List of all Requests Contained in Delta    .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I GET_STATUS                    Delta Activated/Inactivated                                 .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I PROCESSEDALL_SET              Set Pointer: Retrieved from all Receivers                   .
IF_RSB_REQUEST_DELTA           I PROCESSEDONE_SET              Set Pointer: Retrieved from at Least One Receiver           .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I AFTER_EXECUTION               After Execution of Service for All Data Packages            .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I BEFORE_EXECUTION              Before Execution of Service for All Data Packages           .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I CHECK                         Check for Extraction Validity                               .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I DOIT                          Executes Service                                            .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I INSTANTIATE                   Instantiating Service                                       .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I REQUEST_ROLLBACK              Request Terminated                                          .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I SET_USTATE_GREEN              Sets Overall Status of Request to 'Green'                   .
IF_RSB_SERVICE                 I SET_USTATE_RED                Sets Overall Status of Request to 'Red'                     .
IF_RSB_SPOK_MAP                I CHANGE_PARMS                  Changing the Mapping Table (Internal)                       .
IF_RSB_SPOK_MAP                I DELETE                        Deletion of Mapping Information                             .
IF_RSB_SPOK_MAP                I GET_INFO                      Reading of Mapping Information                              .
IF_RSB_SPOK_MAP                I GET_PROPOSAL                  Default Values                                              .
IF_RSB_SPOK_MAP                I SAVE                          Saving of Mapping Information                               .
IF_RSCNV_DESIGNTIME            I CHECK_METADATA_NOWRITE        Checks if the conv grp is valid                             .
IF_RSCNV_DESIGNTIME            I GET_IMPACT                    Gets list of objects that will be affected by the conversion.
IF_RSCNV_EXIT                  I EXIT                          This method is used as the filling method during conversion..
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I ABORT_REQUEST                 Abort a request.                                            .
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I ABORT_STEP                    Abort a step in the request.                                .
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I DELETE_REQUEST                Delete a request.                                           .
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I RESET_REQUEST                 Reset a request.                                            .
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I RESET_STEP                    Reset step of a request.                                    .
IF_RSCNV_MONITOR               I RESTART_REQUEST               Restart a request.                                          .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I CHECK_OPERATION               Checks the operation parameters                             .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I CONVERT                       Used in conversion exit; has field-filling logic            .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I DEMARSHAL                     Returns the attributes which define the operation as an itab.
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I GET_AS_RECORD                 Returns the operation description as a record (tabl RSCNVCG).
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I GET_DESC                      Returns a T100 msg structure describing the operation       .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I GET_DIMENSION                 Gets the dimension                                          .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I GET_OPNO                      Returns the op number of the operation                      .
IF_RSCNV_OPERATION             I GET_OPTYPE                    Returns the optype of the operation                         .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I ACTIVATE                      Activates the infoprovider                                  .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I CHECK_DIMENSION               Checks for the validity of dimension                        .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I CHECK_ENQUEUE                 Checks whether infoprovider is enqueued or not              .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I CHECK_INFOOBJECT              Checks the infoobjects used in operation definition         .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I CHECK_METADATA_WRITELOG       Modifies, checks, saves metadata; writes status to appl log .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I CHECK_METADATA_WRITETAB       Checks the cnv grp; makes entries in the appl tables        .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I DEQUEUE                       Dequeue inforpovider                                        .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I ENQUEUE                       Enqueue infoprovider                                        .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I GET_DIME_OF_IOBJ              Gets dimension to which an infoobject belongs               .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I GET_FIELDNM                   Gets name of the table field corresponding to an infobject  .
IF_RSCNV_RUNTIME               I GET_FIELDTYPE                 Gets type of field that exists in the infoprov -SID or CHAVL.
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I EXECUTE                       Execution of the DTP Requests Currently Open                .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_DATASOURCE                Get Name of DataSource                                      .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_DTA_TYPE                  Type of Target                                              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_OBJSTAT                   Object Status                                               .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_READ_POINTER_TSTMP        Delivers Current Read Time Stamp                            .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_TH_REQUID_SRC_NEW         Source Requests Not Yet Read by DTP                         .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I GET_UPTODATE                  Check Whether DataStore Has Same Status As PSA              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I OPEN_REQUEST_DTP              Opening a DTP Request                                       .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I REPAIR                        Get Last Request in Case of Errors                          .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_DTP             I REPAIR_PREPARE                Prepare Repair                                              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I CLOSE_REQUEST                 Closes Open DTP Request                                     .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I DEQUEUE                       Dequeue for SRC and DTP Management                          .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I ENQUEUE                       Enqueue for SRC and DTP Management                          .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_ACTUAL_DATAPACKAGE        Returns ID of the Currently Open Data Package               .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_ACTUAL_REQUEST            Returns ID of the Current Open Requests                     .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_DATAPAKID_STATE           Returns Status of the Specified Data Package                .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_DATATARGET                Get Name of InfoProvider                                    .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_LAST_DATAPACKAGE          Returns ID of Last Data Package                             .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_OBJECT_REF                Returns Reference to Interface                              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_REALTIME_STATE            Returns Status of Real-Time Updating                        .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_REQUEST_STATE             Returns Status of the Specified Request                     .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_ROWCOUNT_OPEN_DATAPACKAGE Returns Number of Records in Current Open Data Package      .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I GET_VARIANT                   Returns ID of the Demon Component                           .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I REALTIME_POSSIBLE             Indicator: Object Supports Real-time Processes              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I RESET                         Resets the Request Management                               .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_REQUEST_HANDLER I SET_OBJECT_STATUS             Transfer Status of Real-Time Object                         .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I CLOSE_DATAPACKAGE             Close Data Package                                          .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I CONFIRM                       Sets Indicator 'Read' on the Transport Package              .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I FREE_MEMORY                   Releases Memory for Transport Package Again                 .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I GET_DATA                      Gets Transport Package from the Extractor and Puts in Memory.
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I GET_SETTINGS                  Get User Settings from InfoPackage-UI                       .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I GET_TID_STATUS                Get Status of TID Table                                     .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I OPEN_DATAPACKAGE              Open Data Package                                           .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I OPEN_REQUEST                  Opening of Request                                          .
IF_RSCRT_DEMON_SRC             I PUSH_DATASOURCE               Get DataSource Type                                         .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I CLEAR                         Resets ID of This Data Package                              .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I CLEAR_ID                      Obsolete                                                    .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I CLOSE                         Closes This Data Package                                    .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I GET_ID                        Returns ID of This Data Package                             .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I INIT                          Initializes This Data Package                               .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I LOAD                          Loads Data to This Data Package                             .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I OPEN                          Opens New Data Package                                      .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I READ_IF_CLOSED                Checks whether data package has been closed                 .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I READ_LAST                     Finds Last Data Package                                     .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_DATAPACKAGE       I READ_LAST_OPEN                Finds Last Data Package That Is Still Open                  .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I CLEAR                         Resets ID and SID of Request                                .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I CLOSE                         Closes This Request                                         .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I GET_ID                        Returns ID of This Request                                  .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I GET_SID                       Returns SID of This Request                                 .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I INIT                          Initializes This Request                                    .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I OPEN                          Opens a New Request                                         .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I READ_IF_DELETED               Determines if Request was Deleted                           .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_REQUEST           I READ_STATUS                   Determines Current Request Status                           .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_ASSIGNED_DTPS             Returns Assigned DTP Objects                                .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_DEMON45                   Returns Number of Assigned Daemon                           .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_STATUS_DMN                Returns RDA Status of Daemon Object                         .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_STATUS_DTP                Returns RDA Status for DTP                                  .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_STATUS_DTPS               Returns RDA Status of All Assigned DTPs                     .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I GET_STATUS_NDS                Returns RDA Status for InfoPackage                          .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I IS_QM_ACTION_ALLOWED          Checks whether a QM action is permitted                     .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I READ_FROM_DB                  Reads Data from Database (Again)                            .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I READ_FROM_DB_SYNCHRONISED     Reads Data Locked by Database                               .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I SET_RDASTATUS_DMN             Changes RDA Status of Daemon Object                         .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I WRITE_STATUS_DMN              Sets RDA Status of Daemon Object                            .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I WRITE_STATUS_DTP              Sets RDA Status for DTP                                     .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I WRITE_STATUS_DTP_NO_COMMIT    Sets RDA Status for InfoPackage (Without COMMIT)            .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_STATUS            I WRITE_STATUS_NDS              Sets RDA Status for InfoPackage                             .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_TABLES            I DEQUEUE_DEMON                 Unlocks RSCRT_RDA_REQ                                       .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_TABLES            I DEQUEUE_REQ                   Unlocks RSCRT_RDA_REQ                                       .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_TABLES            I ENQUEUE_DEMON_WAITING         Locks Table RSCRT_RDA_DEMON Exclusively                     .
IF_RSCRT_RDA_TABLES            I ENQUEUE_REQ_WAITING           Locks Table RSCRT_RDA_REQ Exclusively                       .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I ALTER_REQUEST                 Change Status of Nearline Request                           .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I ALTER_TABLE                   Enhance Nearline Table Definition                           .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I CONNECT                       Build Connection with Nearline Service                      .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I CREATE_REQUEST                Generate Nearline Request                                   .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I CREATE_TABLE                  Create Nearline Table                                       .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I DROP_TABLE                    Delete Nearline Table                                       .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I GET_SERVICE_PROPERTIES        Query Global Properties of Nearline Service                 .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I OPEN_CURSOR                   Open Cursor on Nearline Table                               .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_CONNECTION   I OPEN_FOR_WRITE                Open Connection to Write Nearline Request                   .
IF_RSDAI_NEARLINE_WRITER       I CLOSE                         Abort the current data load                                 .
IF_RSDAS_PROVIDER              I DESCRIBE                      Reading of the Interface Description of the Service         .
IF_RSDAS_PROVIDER              I GET_OBJECT_DETAILS            Determines Data for the Basis BW Object of the Service      .
IF_RSDAS_PROVIDER              I GET_VARIANTS                  Determines Possible Variants of the Service                 .
IF_RSDAS_PROVIDER              I PROCESS                       Execution of Service                                        .
IF_RSDA_DAP_DISPLAY            I GET_TIMBASNM                  Base Characteristic of Time Slice Characteristic            .
IF_RSDA_DAP_DISPLAY            I REQUIRES_FISCAL_YEAR_VARIANT  Requires Fiscal Year Variant                                .
IF_RSDA_DAP_EXECUTE            I CALL_ADK_ARCHIVE_ADMIN        Call ADK Administration                                     .
IF_RSDA_DAP_EXECUTE            I CHECK_RUNTIME_CONSISTENCY     Check Runtime Consistency (InfoProvider "-" Nearline Object).
IF_RSDA_DAP_EXECUTE            I GET_DOBKEYDESCR               Type Description of Data Object Key                         .
IF_RSDDK_PARALLEL              I CHECK_PROCESS                 Checks Whether a Process Was Successful                     .
IF_RSDDK_PARALLEL              I GET_BATCHID                   Provides an ID for the Processes (Prefix + UID)             .
IF_RSDDK_PARALLEL              I GET_FUNCNAME                  Provides the Name of the Function Module                    .
IF_RSDDK_PARALLEL              I GET_PROCESSTYPE               Provides the Proces Type (See DBTab RSBATCHDEBUGTYPE)       .
IF_RSDDK_PARALLEL              I IS_POSSIBLE                   Checks whether Processing Is Permitted                      .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I ACTIVATE                      Activate/Create                                             .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I FILL                          Initial Filling                                             .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I REALIGN                       Change Run                                                  .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I ROLLUP                        Rollup to...                                                .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I SHADOW                        Create/Fill/Rename Fact and P-Dim as Shadow Index           .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGREGATE          I TRUNCATE                      CLEAR/TRUNCATE                                              .
IF_RSDDTREX_AGGR_PROCESS       I EXECUTE                       Execute Process                                             .
IF_RSDDTREX_WRITEINDEX         I CHECK_INDEX                   Check Index Data Against DB Table                           .
IF_RSDDTREX_WRITEINDEX         I READ_INDEX                    Reads Index Data from (by SEARCH DOCUMENTS)                 .
IF_RSDDTREX_WRITEINDEX         I WRITE_INDEX                   Fill Index in Different Modes                               .
IF_RSDDTREX_WRITEINDEX         I WRITE_INDEX_SHADOW            Completely Fill Shadow Index                                .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I ADD_MESSAGE                   Insert a Message                                            .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I DEC_CURRENT_DETLEVEL          Change Current Detail Level                                 .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I DISPLAY_CURRENT_LOG           Display Current Log                                         .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I GET_CURRENT_DETLEVEL          Return Current Detail Level                                 .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I GET_LOG_HANDLE                Return LOGHANDLE                                            .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I GET_MESSAGE_HANDLES           Return Previous Messages HANDLES                            .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I INC_CURRENT_DETLEVEL          Increase Current Detail Level                               .
IF_RSDDTZA_APPL_LOG_SBAL       I SAVE_LOG_TO_DB                Save Current Log                                            .
IF_RSDDTZA_MSG_LOG_DISPLAY     I APPEND_ACTION_MSG             Attach Message                                              .
IF_RSDDTZA_MSG_LOG_DISPLAY     I CLEAR                         Delete log                                                  .
IF_RSDDTZA_MSG_LOG_DISPLAY     I FREE                          Cleans the Objects                                          .
IF_RSDDTZA_MSG_LOG_DISPLAY     I REFRESH                       Refresh Log                                                 .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONNECTION        I GET_CONN_PARAMS               Get connection parameters                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONNECTION        I GET_REF_REPOSITORY            Gets the reference to the repository                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONNPARAM_FACTORY I GET_CONNECTION_PARAMS         Get the parameters necessary to establish a connection      .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONN_ABAP         I GET_ALL_ENGINES               Get all engines supported                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONN_FACTORY      I GET_CONNECTION                Get DataMining Connection                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_CONN_PARAMS       I GET_PARAM_VALUE               Get value of named parameter                                .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I CHECK_MODEL                   Check the model                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_CONNECTION_PARAMS         Get connection parameters                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_DESCRIPTION               Engine Description                                          .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_DESCRIPTION_ALL           Get Description                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_ENGINE_ID                 Returns the engine identifier                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_ENGINE_META               Get Engine Metadata                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_ENGINE_NAME               Get Engine Name                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_EXTR_INFO_CLASS           Get Extraction Info Class instance                          .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_EXTR_RT_CLASS             Get Extraction Runtime Class instance                       .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_FIELD_PARAMS_META         Get the field parameters supported by the engine            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_MODEL_INSTANCE            Get Empty Model Instance                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_MODEL_PARAMS_META         Get the model parameters supported by the engine            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_PR_INFO_INSTANCE          Get Prediction related info retreiver class                 .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_PR_RT_INSTANCE            Get Empty Prediction Runtime Instance for Mass Predictions  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_PR_UI_CLASS               Get Empty Prediction UI Controller Class                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_PR_WHATIF_UI_CLASS        Get Empty Prediction UI Controller Class - What IF predictio.
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_PR_WHAT_IF_RT_INSTANCE    Get Empty Prediction Runtime Instance for What-If Prediction.
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_SUPPORTED_CONTENT_TYPES   Get the content types supported by the engine               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_SUPPORTED_DISTR_TYPES     Get the distribution types                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_TR_RT_INSTANCE            Get Empty Training Runtime Instance                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_VAL_PROCESS_TYPES         Get Supported Value Process Types                           .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_VAL_TYPES                 Get Supported Value Types - Missing/Ignore or any custom    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I GET_WB_UI_FACTORY             Get UI Factory                                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I RESET_MODEL_RESULTS           Reset Model results                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SET_CONNECTION_PARAMS         Set the connection parameters                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SET_ENGINE_ID                 Sets the engine identifier                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SET_ENGINE_META               Set Engine Metadata                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SET_ENGINE_NAME               Set Engine Name                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SUPPORTS_CHECK_GENERAL        Support Checks - General                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SUPPORTS_CHECK_MODELLING      Support Checks for Modeling Related Activities              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SUPPORTS_CHECK_PREDICTION     Support Checks for Prediction Related Activities            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_ENGINE            I SUPPORTS_CHECK_TRAINING       Support Checks for Training Related Activities              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I CHECK                         Check Model                                                 .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I EXISTS_ON_DB                  Model Exists on Db? X: Yes                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_ADDITIONAL_HDR_INFO       Get addnl hdr info - timestamp, user info etc               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_AS_PMML                   Get model in PMML format                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Model Description                                       .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_DESCRIPTION_ALL           Get description in all stored languages                     .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_ENGINE_ID                 Get Engine ID                                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_ENGINE_NAME               Get Engine Name                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_MODEL_FIELDS              Get Model Fields                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_MODEL_FIELDS_STR          Get Model Fields in usage Structure Format                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_MODEL_PARAMETERS          Get Model Parameters                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_MODEL_STATE               Get Model State                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_NAME                      Get name                                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_REF_ENGINE                Get Engine Reference                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I GET_VERSION                   Get Model Version                                           .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I IS_ACTIVE                     Is Model Active?                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I IS_LOCKED                     Do Not Use !!!                                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I IS_TRAINED                    Is Model Trained?                                           .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I RESET_MODEL_RESULTS           Reset Model Results                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set model description                                       .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_ENGINE_ID                 Set Engine ID                                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_ENGINE_NAME               Set Engine Name                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_MODEL_FIELDS              Set Model Fields                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_MODEL_PARAMETERS          Set Model Parameters                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_MODEL_STATE               Set Model State - New/Trained                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_NAME                      Set name                                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_REF_ENGINE                Set Engine Reference                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL             I SET_VERSION                   Set Model Version                                           .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I CHECK                         Check field consistency                                     .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Set Content Type                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I GET_DATA_TYPE_INFO            Set Datatype information                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I GET_NAME                      Get Field Name                                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I IS_NUMERIC                    Is Numeric Field?                                           .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I IS_PREDICTABLE                Is the field predictable (or defined as Target )            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_CONTENT_TYPE              Set Content Type                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_DATA_TYPE_INFO            Set Datatype information                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_DEFAULTS                  Set Defaults                                                .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set Description                                             .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_NAME                      Set Name                                                    .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD       I SET_PREDICTABLE               Set Predictable flag                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I ADD_FIELD                     Add field to collection                                     .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I CHECK                         Check Model Fields Consistency                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MAX_PRED_FIELDS           Get allowed Prediction Fields                               .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MODEL_FIELD               Get specified Model Field                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MODEL_FIELDS_STR          Model Fields - In defined Structure                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MODEL_FIELD_INSTANCE      Factory for model field                                     .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MODEL_FIELD_LIST          Collection of Model Fields                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_MODEL_KEYS                Get Model Fields defined/act as Keys                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I GET_SUP_CONTENT_TYPES         Get Supported Content Types                                 .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I HAS_PREDICTION_FIELDS         Has Prediction Fields                                       .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I REMOVE_FIELD                  Remove field from collection                                .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I RENAME_FIELD                  Rename given field                                          .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELDS      I SET_PROPOSED_FIELDS           Set Proposed Fields (from APD)                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD_3P    I SUPPORTS_FIELD_PARAMS         Supports Field Parameters                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_FIELD_3P    I SUPPORTS_FIELD_VALUES         Supports Field Values                                       .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_OUTPUT      I GET_ENGINE                    Get Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_OUTPUT      I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_OUTPUT      I SET_ENGINE                    Set Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_MODEL_OUTPUT      I SET_MODEL                     Set Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check user authority for model for a task                   .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I CHECK_MODEL_NAME              Check the model name                                        .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I COPY_MODEL                    Copy model                                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I DELETE_MODEL                  Delete Model from Database                                  .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I GET_ALL_MODELS                Get List of Models                                          .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I GET_ENGINE_INSTANCE           Get the instance of the class for the engine interface      .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I GET_MODEL_OBJECT              Get model object                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I LOCK_MODEL                    Lock the model                                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I MODEL_EXISTS_ON_DB            Model Exists on DB?                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I RESET_MODEL_RESULTS           Reset Model Results                                         .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I SAVE_MODEL                    Save Model to Database                                      .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I SEARCH_MODEL                  Search for model                                            .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY        I UNLOCK_MODEL                  Unlock model                                                .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY_SAP    I ACTIVATE_MODEL                Activate Model                                              .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY_SAP    I RESET_MODEL_TO_ACTIVE         Reset model to active state                                 .
IF_RSDME_DMP_REPOSITORY_SAP    I UPDATE_TRAINING_STATUS        Update Training Status                                      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_CALLPACKAGE               get Call Package                                            .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_DIALOG_METAINFO           Meta Info as coming from Call Package Builder - Getter      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_ENGINE                    Get Associated Engine                                       .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_FCODE                     Get FCode                                                   .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_HELP                      Get Help                                                    .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_MODE                      Get Mode                                                    .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_PARAMETERS                get parameters list                                         .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_PRED_INFO_INSTANCE        Get Prediction Info                                         .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I GET_SCREEN                    Get Screen details for given Screen ID                      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I HANDLE_MODEL_CHANGE           Handle Mining Model Changes                                 .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I SET_CALLPACKAGE               set Call Package                                            .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I SET_DIALOG_METAINFO           Meta Info as coming from Call Package Builder - Setter      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I SET_FCODE                     Set FCode                                                   .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I SET_MODE                      Set Mode                                                    .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_CONTROLLER      I SET_PARAMETERS                set parameters list                                         .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I CLOSE                         Close event - free any screen resources like controllers etc.
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I GET_SCREEN_INFO               Get Screen Information                                      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I HANDLE_F4                     Handle F4                                                   .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I HANDLE_PAI                    Handle the PAI events                                       .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I HANDLE_PBO                    Handle PBO events                                           .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Screen Attributes - Called when model changes    .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN          I SET_CONTROLLER                Set Controller                                              .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I ADAPT_MAPPING                 Adapt Mapping Table on changes to Model                     .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I CHECK_MAPPING                 Check the mapping for specified line                        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I CHECK_MAPPING_ALL             Check the Mapping for all lines in the mapping table        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I DEFAULT_MAP_BY_NAMES          Propose default Mapping by Names                            .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I GET_DATA_FIELDS               Get Data fields                                             .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I GET_MODEL_FIELDS              Get Model Input fields                                      .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_IN   I HANDLE_PAI                    Handle PAI                                                  .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I ADAPT_MAPPING                 Adapt Mapping Table on changes to Model                     .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I ADD_DATA_FIELD                Add a new data field                                        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I CHECK_MAPPING                 Check the mapping for specified line                        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I CHECK_MAPPING_ALL             Check the Mapping for all lines in the mapping table        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I GET_MODEL_FIELDS              Get Model Input & Output fields                             .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I HANDLE_PAI                    Handle PAI                                                  .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_MAP_OUT  I REMOVE_DATA_FIELD             Remove a data field that was added                          .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_PARAMS   I CHECK                         Check all prediction parameters                             .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_PARAMS   I CHECK_PARAM                   Check specified prediction parameter                        .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_PARAMS   I GET_PARAMS_AS_NAME_VALUE      Get Parameters as Name Value Pairs                          .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_PARAMS   I GET_PARAM_F4                  Get the prediction parameter possible values                .
IF_RSDME_IS_UI_SCREEN_PARAMS   I GET_PARAM_METADATA            Get the prediction parameter metadata - data type info      .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_ENGINE                    Get Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_FIELD_VALUES              Get possible values for given input field - used in What-IF .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_MAX_RANK                  Get Maximum Ranks                                           .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_MODEL_INPUT_FIELDS        Get all prediction input fields (model signature)           .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_MODEL_REF                 Get associated Model Instance                               .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_PRED_OUTPUT_FIELDS        Get all Prediction output fields                            .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_PRED_PARAMS               Get Prediction Parameters Metadata                          .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_PRIMARY_PRED_FIELD        Get the Primary Prediction Output Field                     .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I GET_PRIMARY_PRED_FIELD_VALUES Get all primary prediction output field Values              .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I IS_READY_FOR_PREDICTION       Is model ready for prediction??                             .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I SET_ENGINE                    Set Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I SET_MODEL                     Set Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I SUPPORTS_EVALUATION           Supports Evaluation Run                                     .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I SUPPORTS_MAP_BY_VALUE         Supports Mapping against specified Target Value             .
IF_RSDME_PRED_INFO             I SUPPORTS_RANK                 Supports Rank                                               .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I CHECK                         Consistency Check of input parameters                       .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I CHECK_DATAOBJ                 Check Incoming Data Fields                                  .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I CHECK_MAPPING                 Check Mapping                                               .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I CHECK_MODEL                   Check Model                                                 .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I CHECK_PARAMS                  Check Prediction Parameter values                           .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I EXECUTE                       Execute Prediction                                          .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I FINISH                        End of Prediction Calls                                     .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I GET_EVAL_SUMMARY_OBJS         Get Summary Objects                                         .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I INIT                          Start of Prediction Calls                                   .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_EVALUATION_FLAG           Set Evaluation Flag                                         .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_INPUT_DATA                set input data                                              .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_INPUT_DATA_METADATA       Metadata about Incoming Data - Fields, Layout etc           .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_MAPPING                   Mapping Table for Prediction Fields to Data fields          .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_MODEL                     Set Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_MASS     I SET_PRED_PARAMS               Any engine-specific runtime prediction parameters           .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I CHECK_VALUE                   Check Value                                                 .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I EXECUTE                       Execute What-If Analysis                                    .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I GET_OUTPUT_ALL                Get all outputs                                             .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I GET_OUTPUT_VALUE              Get Prediction Output for specified field (default rank = 1).
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I SET_ENGINE                    Set Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I SET_INPUT_DATA                Set Input data                                              .
IF_RSDME_PRED_TASK_RT_WHATIF   I SET_MODEL                     Set Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I CLOSE                         End of Data Inputs                                          .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I FINISH                        End of Process Execution                                    .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I FREE                          Free any memory/disc usage                                  .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I GET_APD_MODEL_REF             Getter -  APD DM Adapter Reference                          .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I GET_ARUN_INFO                 Getter - Analysis RUN ID                                    .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I INIT                          Start of Process Execution                                  .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I OPEN                          Start of data input                                         .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I PUT                           Receive data input                                          .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I SET_APD_MODEL_REF             Setter - APD DM Adapter Reference                           .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I SET_ARUN_INFO                 Setter - Analysis RUN ID                                    .
IF_RSDME_TRAIN_RUNTIME         I SET_INPUT_FIELDS              Input Fields Information                                    .
IF_RSDME_UI_ACTION_HANDLER     I HANDLE                        Handle the given function code                              .
IF_RSDME_UI_CONTEXT_MENU       I CREATE                        create context menu                                         .
IF_RSDME_UI_CUSTOM_TOOLBAR     I FREE                          release resources                                           .
IF_RSDME_UI_CUSTOM_TOOLBAR     I INITIALISE                    create sap toolbar control                                  .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_ABAP       I GET_SCREEN_CONTROLLER         return the screen controller class                          .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_ABAP       I INIT_SCREEN_CONTROLLER        create the controller instance                              .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I GET_ACTION_HANDLER            return the action handler class                             .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              return the context menu class                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I GET_ICON                      Get Icon for Display                                        .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I GET_WORKBENCH                 return the workbench class                                  .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I INIT_ACTION_HANDLER           create the action handler class                             .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I INIT_CONTEXT_MENU             create the context menu class                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_FACTORY_GEN        I INIT_WORKBENCH                create the workbench class                                  .
IF_RSDME_UI_MODEL_TREE         I CREATE                        create tree                                                 .
IF_RSDME_UI_MODEL_TREE         I FILL_DATA                     fetch data and create nodes                                 .
IF_RSDME_UI_MODEL_TREE         I SET_HANDLER                   set handler                                                 .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I CHECK                         check screen data                                           .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I CHECK_DATA_CHANGE             check if data has changed for                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I FREE                          free resources                                              .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I GET_SCREEN_OBJECT             get the specified screen flow logic object                  .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I GET_TOOLBAR                   return custom toolbar instance                              .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I INITIALISE                    set required screen objects                                 .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I LAUNCH                        initialization and launch                                   .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I PREPARE_LAUNCH                prepare relevant data                                       .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I RETRANSFORM_DATA              display structure to dmpi for all screen objects            .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I SET_REFERENCE                 pass object reference to relevant locations                 .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I SET_SCREEN_OBJECT             set the screen flow logic object                            .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_CONTROLLER  I TRANSFORM_DATA                dmpi to display structure for all screen objects            .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I CHECK_DATA                    perform check                                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I CONVERT_DATA_TO_DMP           convert display data to dmpi structure                      .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I CONVERT_DATA_TO_UI            convert dmpi data to display structure                      .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I FREE                          release resources                                           .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I GET_SUBSCREEN_INFO            return scr no, pgm name for the given subscreen             .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I HANDLE_F1                     handle f1 for the given field                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I HANDLE_F4                     handle f4 for the given field                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I HANDLE_USER_COMMAND           handle f code                                               .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I INTIALISE_SCREEN              any initializations in pbo                                  .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I MANAGE_SCREEN_FIELDS          hide/show screen fields in pbo                              .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I SET_REFERENCE                 place the screen object to the required location            .
IF_RSDME_UI_SCREEN_FLOW_LOGIC  I SET_SUBSCREEN_INFO            set screen number and program name                          .
IF_RSDME_UI_WORKBENCH          I DISPLAY                       launches the workbench                                      .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I CLOSE                         Close all Screen objects                                    .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I EXECUTE                       Execute What -if                                            .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I GET_PRED_INFO_REF             Get Prediction Info Class Ref                               .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I GET_SCREEN                    Get Specified Screen Ref                                    .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I GET_WHATIF_RT_REF             Get What-if Runtime Class Instance                          .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I LAUNCH_UI                     Launch UI                                                   .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I SET_ENGINE                    Set Engine                                                  .
IF_RSDME_WHATIF_UI_CTRL        I SET_MODEL                     Set Model                                                   .
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I CLOSE                         Close event - free any screen resources like controllers etc.
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I GET_SCREEN_INFO               Get Screen Information                                      .
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I HANDLE_PAI                    Handle the PAI events                                       .
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I HANDLE_PBO                    Handle PBO events                                           .
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Screen Attributes - Called when model changes    .
IF_RSDME_WI_UI_SCREEN          I SET_CONTROLLER                Set Controller                                              .
IF_RSDM_FIFO_BUFFER            I INSERT                        Add in Buffer                                               .
IF_RSDM_FIFO_BUFFER            I READ                          Read from Buffer                                            .
IF_RSDM_FIFO_BUFFER            I REFRESH                       Delete Buffer                                               .
IF_RSDM_FIFO_BUFFER            I REORG                         Reorganize Buffer                                           .
IF_RSDM_FIFO_BUFFER            I RESIZE                        Change Sizes                                                .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I EXECUTE                       Execute Delete Operation                                    .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I GET_DEL_CNT                   Return Number of Deleted Data Records                       .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I GET_LOG                       Return Log                                                  .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I GET_STATUS                    Return Current Status of Deletion Process                   .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I GET_SX_QUERY                  Return sx_query Structure                                   .
IF_RSDRD_SELDEL_TAB            I GET_TABLNM                    Return Table Name                                           .
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I CLEANUP                       Cleanup storage object with respect to sequence number      .
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I CREATE                        Create a hierarchy storage object                           .
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I CREATE_REF                    Create reference to an existing external hier storage object.
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I DROP                          Physically drop the Hierarchy Storage object                .
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I READ                          read the hierarchy into an internal table                   .
IF_RSDRH_HIER_STORAGE          I WRITE                         Write the hierarchy to the storage                          .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I BUILD_HINT                    generate the hints for the statement                        .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I BUILD_NTAB__BEFORE_NAMETAB    Before writing nametab information                          .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I BUILD_VIEW__AFTER_CODE_EXE    After Create View has been executed ...                     .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I BUILD_VIEW__AFTER_CODE_GEN    Code generation finished                                    .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I CLEANUP__BEFORE_LEAVING       At the very end of cleanup                                  .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I CLEANUP__DROP_VIEW            drop view                                                   .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I CONSISTENT_READ               Ability to read consistent during one statement             .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I GET_REF_POINT_PART_SID        Retrieve SID of partitioning column for reference points    .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I GET_THRESHOLDS                Get thresholds for query restriction generation             .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I MATERIALIZE__AT_BEGINNING     at beginning of materialize                                 .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I MATERIALIZE__BEFORE_EXEC      before RSDU_EXEC_SQL call                                   .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I MATERIALIZE__BEFORE_LEAVING   At the end of materialize (before analyze)                  .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I OPEN_CURSOR__AT_BEGINNING     at beginning of open cursor                                 .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I PACK_QUERY_INFO               Pack all info in add. to sx_query to run q. in other WP     .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I READ_DATA__AT_BEGINNING       at beginning of read data                                   .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I READ_DATA__GET_ACCESSTP       get access type of query                                    .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I SET_SQL_STMT_REF              Set Reference to SQL Statement                              .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I SIMULATE__AT_BEGINNING        at beginning of simulate                                    .
IF_RSDRS_EXITS_STD             I UNPACK_QUERY_INFO             Unpack all info packed by PACK_QUERY_INFO...                .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I GENERATE_CODE                 Generate the SQL Statement                                  .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I GET_CODE                      Return the generated Code                                   .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I GET_EXIT_CLASS                Return name of class that implements the exit interfaces    .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I GET_EXIT_OBJ_REF              Get Reference to exit class object                          .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I SET_DBOPT_FEATURES            Set Usage of enhanced Database Optimizer Features           .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I SET_DMSTAT_ACCESS_OBJ         Sets a reference to the dmstat access object                .
IF_RSDRS_SQL_STMT              I SHOW                          call editor to display generated statement                  .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_NOSID      I DEQUEUE                       Locking of Transaction Data                                 .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_NOSID      I ENQUEUE                       Locking of Transaction Data with a Selection                .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_NOSID      I GET_LOCK_CHAS                 Lock-Relevant Characteristics of the InfoProvider           .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_SID        I DEQUEUE                       Locking of Transaction Data                                 .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_SID        I ENQUEUE                       Locking of Transaction Data with a Selection                .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_LOCK_SID        I GET_LOCK_CHAS                 Lock-Relevant Characteristics of the InfoProvider           .
IF_RSDRV_RPROV_WRITABLE        I WRITE_DATA                    Writing Data into a Remote InfoProvider                     .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I DEFINE                        Definition of the Query Parameter                           .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I GET_EXEC_ESTIMATE             Complexity of Execution (100 * #Joins or Equivalent)        .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I GET_FIELDS                    Definition of the Required Fields of t_data Table           .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I MATERIALIZE                   Write Result in the Table (If Supported)                    .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I READ                          Read and Return the Data                                    .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY       I SIMULATE                      Display Execution Plan (If Supported)                       .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_INT_QUERY_NCUM  I DEFINE_NCUM                   Definition of the Query Parameter                           .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_LOC_NOSID_QUERY I DEFINE                        Defines Parameters                                          .
IF_RSDRV_VPROV_LOC_NOSID_QUERY I READ                          Reads Data                                                  .
IF_RSDS_ATTRIBUTES_MAINTAIN    I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Screen Parameter in Storage Class                           .
IF_RSDS_ATTRIBUTES_MAINTAIN    I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Subscreen for Maintenance of Attribute                      .
IF_RSDS_ATTRIBUTES_MAINTAIN    I INIT                          Subscreen Initialization                                    .
IF_RSDS_ATTRIBUTES_MAINTAIN    I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Transfer Storage Class to Subscreen                         .
IF_RSDS_CHECK                  I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_RSDS_CONVERT                I GET_CODE                      Generation of a Routine                                     .
IF_RSDS_CONVERT                I GET_TEMPLATE                  Template Name                                               .
IF_RSDS_EXTRACT_DIRECT         I EXTRACT                       Extract data                                                .
IF_RSDS_EXTRACT_GENERATE       I CHARACTERSTRUCTURE            Extraction Only in Character Structure, not Appl Structure  .
IF_RSDS_EXTRACT_GENERATE       I GET_CODE                      Generation of a Routine                                     .
IF_RSDS_EXTRACT_GENERATE       I GET_TEMPLATE                  Template Name                                               .
IF_RSDS_GENERATION_EXIT        I ACTIVATE                      Generation of Additional Objects                            .
IF_RSDS_GENERATION_EXIT        I DELETE                        Deletion of Additional Objects                              .
IF_RSDS_GENERATION_EXIT        I GET_DDIC_OBJECTS              Additional DDIC Objects: Name Determination and Save        .
IF_RSDS_MAINTAINABILITY        I CHANGE                        Change Maintainability of the DataSource                    .
IF_RSDS_MAINTAINABILITY        I POSSIBLE_ATTRIBUTES           Permitted Attribute Values                                  .
IF_RSDS_STORAGE                I CREATE_OBJECT                 Instance Generation                                         .
IF_RSDS_STORAGE                I IS_EMPTY                      All Parameters for the Instance Are Empty                   .
IF_RSDS_STORAGE_TRANSPORT      I GET_RELATED                   Find Related Objects                                        .
IF_RSDS_STRUCTURE_PROPOSE      I GET_STRUCTURE                 Give back new structure of datasource                       .
IF_RSDS_STRUCTURE_PROPOSE      I GET_SUBSCREEN                 Give back the subscreen                                     .
IF_RSDS_STRUCTURE_PROPOSE      I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_RSDS_STRUCTURE_PROPOSE      I SET_DATA                      Retrieve data, if required                                  .
IF_RSDS_STRUCTURE_PROPOSE      I SET_STRUCTURE                 Retrieve actual structure of datasource                     .
IF_RSDU_RECLUST_DB6            I FACTORY                       get instanz reference                                       .
IF_RSDU_RECLUST_DB6            I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_RSDU_RECLUST_DB6            I RESET                         Reset                                                       .
IF_RSDU_RECLUST_DB6            I RUN                           Start                                                       .
IF_RSDU_REPART                 I FACTORY                       get instanz reference                                       .
IF_RSDU_REPART                 I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_RSDU_REPART                 I RESET                         Reset                                                       .
IF_RSDU_REPART                 I RUN                           Start                                                       .
IF_RSD_CONVERT_SID             I GET_NEW_SID                   Returns new SID for Conversion                              .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I CACHE_ADPART                  Should AD part also be cached?                              .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I CREATE                        Constructor Needs InfoProvider                              .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I GET_DATA_TIMESTAMP0           Cannot rename because of SNOTE                              .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I GET_DELTACHANM                Name of Delta Characteristic, such as 0REQUID               .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I GET_DELTAMETHOD               Outputs delta method (delta or timestamp)                   .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I GET_REFRESH                   Should the RQTS be checked with every new list              .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I GET_RQTS                      Provides the Data Fill Levels and the Semantic Content TS   .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I ONLY_AS_DELTA_PART            Only in Delta Pair With DC Support                          .
IF_RSD_DELTACACHE_SUPPORT      I SET_DATA_TIMESTAMP0           Sets TMST0 if Delete/Update in Defined Section              .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I ACTUALDATA_AP                 Sets or Changes AP Part of ACTUALDATA                       .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I CACHE_DELTA                   Should the DELTA part be cached?                            .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I CHECK_DTP                     Check During Generation of MultiProvider                    .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I CREATE                        Generates Transformation Instance                           .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I GET_DELTA_RQTS                Calculates Starting Point of Delta Char.for Delta Part      .
IF_RSD_DELTAPAIR               I SWITCH                        Switch Off AP or DP Parts As Required                       .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I ACTIVATE                      Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I BUILD_CONTENT                 Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I CHANGE_INFOAREA               Change InfoArea (also Delete InfoArea)                      .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I CHECK                         Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I DELETE                        Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I DELETE_DATA                   Delete Data                                                 .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I DTA_GET_INFO                  Supplies the Information for a Data Target (Trans. Data)    .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I EXISTS_DATA                   Does Data Exist?                                            .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_ADJOINT_PROVIDER          Provide Reference to Adjoint Provider of Specific Type      .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_ADJOINT_TYPE              Determine Type of (Adjoint) Provider                        .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_AMBIGUOUS_JOIN_INFO       Info About Non Unique Joins Within InfoProvider Schema      .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_DATA_TIMESTMP             Read Time of Last Data Change                               .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_MAINTENANCE_STATE         Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I GET_SRDATE                    Provides Key Date/ Key Date Varaible of Provider            .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I HAS_ADJOINT_PROVIDER          InfoProvider has Adjoint Provider                           .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I INIT_DATASTATE                Initialize DataState Variable (for New InfoProvider)        .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I IS_ACTIVE                     Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I IS_SAVED                      Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I POSTPROCESS_DTA_PRO           TLOGO-Specific Post Prcssng of DTA_PRO (after BUILD_DTA_PRO).
IF_RSD_DTA                     I POSTPROCESS_S_DTA             TLOGO-specific Postprocessing of E_S_DTA                    .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I PREPARE                       Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I READ_NEW_FROM_DB              Rereads object from the database                            .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I RESET_TO_ACTIVE               Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SAVE                          Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SET_DATASTATE                 Set DataState Variables                                     .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SET_DATA_TIMESTMP             Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SET_MAINTENANCE_STATE         Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SET_OBJSTAT                   Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I SHOW_PROTOCOL                 Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_DTA                     I VERSION_EXISTS                Writes Time of Last Data Change                             .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I ADAPT_OBJ_AFTER_DD            Adjust Object According to D&D Operation                    .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I ADD_NODES                     Generate Tree for Object with Nodes                         .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I CHANGE_DESC_DIME              Change Description of a Dimension                           .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I CHANGE_DESC_HNODE             Change Description of a Hierarchy Node                      .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I CHANGE_DESC_TOP               Change Description of Object                                .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I CHANGE_OBJ_TYPE               Change Type of Object (Data Store)                          .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_DELTA_PAIR               Dialog: Delta Pairs                                         .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_DIME                     Dialog: Process Dimension                                   .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_HNODE                    Dialog: Process Hierarchy Node                              .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_IDENT_IOBJ               Identify InfoObjects                                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INDEX                    Dialog: Process Indexes                                     .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INFO                     Dialog: Info Dialog Box                                     .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INSERT_DIME              Dialog: Create Dimension                                    .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INSERT_HNODE             Dialog: Create Hierarchy Node                               .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INSERT_INDEX             Dialog: Create Indexes                                      .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_INSERT_IOBJ              Dialog: Insert InfoObjects                                  .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_MDCCLUSTER               Dialog: Multi-Dimensional Clustering                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_MOLAP                    Dialog: MOLAP Cube                                          .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_PARTITION                Dialog: Partitioning                                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_STORPAR                  Dialog: Memory Parameters                                   .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_UPDR                     Dialog: Update Rules                                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DIAL_VALT                     Dialog: Non-Cumulative Value Parameter                      .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I DISPLAY_USAGE                 Display usage                                               .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I ENABLE_DRAG_DROP              Switch Drag & Drop on/off                                   .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I FREE_TREE                     Deletes Tree (incl.Display)                                 .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_CMENU_CONTENT             Context Menu for Content                                    .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_CMENU_TOP                 Context Menu for Top Node                                   .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_DD_HANDLE                 Provide Drag and Drop Handle                                .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_DIME_SNG                  Delivers Info about Individual Dimension                    .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_EXCL_FUNC                 Gets Excluded Functions                                     .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_HNODE_SNG                 Delivers Info about Individual Hierarchy Node               .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_IOBJ                      Provides InfoObjects                                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_IOBJ_SNG                  Provides Info for a Single InfoObject                       .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_STATUS                    Provides GUI Status and Title                               .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I GET_S_DDIC_FOR_PROP           Provide DDIC Structure for Properties                       .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I INIT_APPL_LOG                 Initialize Log (for Check, Save,...)                        .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I INIT_DIME_FOR_NEW_OBJ         Create Initial Dimensions for New Object                    .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I INSERT_IOBJ_TO_DIME           Insert InfoObjects in Dimension                             .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I MERGE_HIER_NODES              Merge Hierarchy Nodes                                       .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I OBJ_SPECIFIC_IOBJ_PRO         Object-Specific InfoObject Properties                       .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I REMOVE_DIME                   Remove Dimension                                            .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I REMOVE_HNODE                  Remove Hierarchy Node                                       .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I REMOVE_INA                    Remove Inactive InfoObjects                                 .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I REMOVE_INDEX                  Remove Index                                                .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I SELECT_IOBJ                   Select Key Figures                                          .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I SHOW_COMPARISON               Version Comparison (Display)                                .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I SHOW_DATA                     Display Data                                                .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I SHOW_TADIR                    Display TADIR Entry                                         .
IF_RSD_GUI_MDOB                I UTIL_FUNC                     Utility Functions (Search, Sort)                            .
IF_RSD_IOBJ_CHANGED_HANDLER    I IOBJ_CHANGED                  An InfoObject Has Changed                                   .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I ADAPT_NAV_ATTR                Adapts List of the Nav. Attr.                               .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I ADAPT_UNITS                   Adapts List of Units                                        .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I ADD_INDEX                     Create New Index                                            .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I ADD_IOBJ_TO_DIME              Adds InfoObjects to Dimension                               .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I ADD_IOBJ_TO_INDEX             Insert InfoObjects in Index                                 .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I CHECK_VERS_EXIST              Checks Existency of Versions                                .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I DELETE_INDEX                  Delete Index                                                .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I DELETE_IOBJ                   Deletes InfoObjects from the Current Version                .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I DELETE_IOBJ_IN_INDEX          Delete InfoObjects from Index                               .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_BCTCOMP                   Provide BCT Components                                      .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_DIME_IOBJTP               Provide Type of a Dimension                                 .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_DIME_TO_IOBJ              Delivers Dimension to an InfoObject                         .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_ENV_STATUS                Delivers Environment Status of an InfoProvider              .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_INFO_MAINT                Provides Info on Object in Normal Display                   .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_IOBJ_PRO                  Returns the Specific Properties for an InfoObject           .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_NEXT_INDEX_ID             Returns Next Free Index ID                                  .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I GET_OBJ_STATUS                Delivers Version, Save Status, Obj. Status for Current Vrsn .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I INIT_IOBJ_FOR_DIAL            Initializes InfoObjects for Dialog                          .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I INIT_OBJ_IN_CLASS             Initializes the Object to be Maintained in its Class        .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I INSERT_DIME                   Insert New Dimension                                        .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I IS_INDEX_ID                   Determines if Valid Index ID                                .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I REMOVE_DIME                   Delete dimension                                            .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I REMOVE_INA                    Delete Inactive InfoObjects                                 .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I RENAME_DIME                   Rename Dimension                                            .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_BCTCOMP                   Set BCT Component                                           .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_CHECK_IOBJ_LOCD           Sets Lock Flag for InfoObjects                              .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_FLAGS                     Sets Flags for Data State / MOLAP                           .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_HIE_INFO                  Sets Hierarchy Info                                         .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_INDX_INFO                 Sets Index Info                                             .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_IOBJ_FOR_VALT             Sets InfoObjects that are in Validity Table                 .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_IOBJ_IDENT                Sets the Identification Table                               .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_IOBJ_PRO                  Sets the Specific Properties for an InfoObject              .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_MDC_INFO                  Set the Info for MDC                                        .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_PART_INFO                 Set Partitioning Info                                       .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_PART_PROV                 Set Involved InfoProvider                                   .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_STORPAR                   Sets Storage Parameters                                     .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_TECH_INFO                 Set Technical Info                                          .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_TEXT                      Sets Object Description                                     .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_TEXT_HNODE                Sets Description for Hierarchy Node                         .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_TYPE                      Sets Type of DataStore                                      .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SET_VERS                      Sets the Current Version                                    .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SWITCH_NAV_ATTR_ON_OFF        Switches a Navigation Attribute On or Off                   .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I SWITCH_TO_MODIFY              Initialization after Switching to Change Mode               .
IF_RSD_STRUCT_MAINT            I UPDATE_DIME                   Modify/Insert Dimension                                     .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I EFACT                         E Fact Table Partitioning Type                              .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I FFACT                         F Fact Table Partitioning Type                              .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I ODSO                          ODSO Table Partitioning Type                                .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I ODSO_WRITE                    Write Optimitized ODSO Table Partitioning Type              .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I ON_OFF_SWITCH                 Return Global On/Off Switch for Table Partitioning          .
IF_RSD_TABL_PART               I PSA                           PSA Table Partitioning Type                                 .
IF_RSFO_COMPILE                I CHECK_CODE                    Syntax Check of Compiled Formula                            .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I GET_CURRENT_SAVEDFL           Setting the Indicator: Saved / Not Saved                    .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I GET_OBJ_STATUS                Returns Version, Status, Save of the Current Version        .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I SAVE_WITH_CONFIRMATION        Saving the TLOGO Object with Query                          .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I SET_CURRENT_SAVEDFL           Setting the Saved / Not Saved Indicator                     .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I SET_CURRENT_VERSION           Setting the Current Version                                 .
IF_RSGM_MODEL_TLOGO            I SWITCH_MODE                   Change Editing MOde: Display "-" Change                     .
IF_RSISC_COPY_PARAM            I SAVE_SETTINGS                 Get Data at End of Dialog                                   .
IF_RSISC_COPY_PARAM            I SET_NEW_TABLE                 Call New Dialog                                             .
IF_RSISR_BLOCKS                I GET_CURRENT_BLOCK_LINE        Return of Current Block Lines                               .
IF_RSISR_BLOCKS                I SET_CURRENT_BLOCK_LINE        Setting Current Block Lines                                 .
IF_RSISR_CALLPACKAGE_BUILDER   I GET_CUR_MSG                   Returns the Current Message, Especially Errors During Check .
IF_RSISR_CALLPACKAGE_BUILDER   I GET_VALUE_HELP                Returns the F4 Help for a Parameter                         .
IF_RSISR_CALLPACKAGE_BUILDER   I SET_CALL_PACKAGE_DESCRIPTION  Sets the Call Package Description                           .
IF_RSISR_CALLPACKAGE_BUILDER   I SET_DATAOBJ_DESC              Sets the Data Object Description                            .
IF_RSISR_CHECK                 I CHECK                         Complete Check                                              .
IF_RSISR_CHECK                 I CHECK_DATAOBJ_DESC            Checking a Data Object Description                          .
IF_RSISR_CHECK                 I CHECK_PARAMETER               Checking a Parameter                                        .
IF_RSISR_CHECK                 I CHECK_STATE                   Checking a Status                                           .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I FINISH_DATAOBJ_DESC           Postprocessing Before Saving Service Type                   .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I GET_FIRST_STATE               Return of the First Status (Refernce)                       .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I GET_NAME_OF_FIRST_STATE       Return of the First Status (Name)                           .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I GET_NAME_OF_NEXT_STATE        Return of the Subsequent Status (Name)                      .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I GET_NEXT_STATE                Return of the Subsequent Status (Reference)                 .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I INIT_DATAOBJ_DESC             Modify with Each Instantiation of the Service Type          .
IF_RSISR_CP_CREATION           I INIT_PARAMETER                Initialization of Parameter when Creating Service Type      .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_CHARACTERISTICS           Return of Characteristics of a Data Object                  .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_DATAOBJ_DESC_LIST         Return of Data Object Description as a List of Names        .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_PARAMETER_LIST            Return of the Parameter as a List of Names                  .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_PROPERTIES                Return of Properties                                        .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_REFERENCES                Return of References                                        .
IF_RSISR_METADATA              I GET_SUMMARY_LIST              Return of Summary Data Objects as a List of Names           .
IF_RSISR_PARAMETERIZATION      I GET_METAINFO                  Returns Global Metainfo                                     .
IF_RSISR_PARAMETERIZATION      I SET_CONDITIONS                Gets the Conditions                                         .
IF_RSISR_PARAMETERIZATION      I SET_DATAOBJ_DESC              Gets the Values for a Data Object Description               .
IF_RSISR_PARAMETERIZATION      I SET_METAINFO                  Sets Global Metainfo for a Dialog                           .
IF_RSISR_PARAMETERIZATION      I SET_STATE_PARAMETERS          Gets the Parameters for a State                             .
IF_RSISR_REFERENCEDATA         I EXTEND_BLOCK_DATA             Expands the Block Line Table                                .
IF_RSISR_REFERENCEDATA         I GET_REFDATA_SELECTION         Return of Reference Data Selection                          .
IF_RSISR_REFERENCEDATA         I GET_REF_DATAOBJ               Return of Reference Data Object                             .
IF_RSISR_REFERENCEDATA         I SET_REF_DATAOBJ               Setting the Reference Data Object                           .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I FINISH_SERVICE                End (After Calling the Last Block)                          .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_DATAOBJ                   Return of a Data Object                                     .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_DATAOBJ_DESC              Return of a Data Object Description                         .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_IMPLICIT_PARAMETERS       Return of Implicitly Used Parameters                        .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_PARAMETER                 Returning a Parameter                                       .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_PARAMETER_VALUES          Return of All Values of a Parameter                         .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I GET_SUMMARY                   Return of a Summary Data Object                             .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I INIT_SERVICE                  Initialization (Before Calling the First Block)             .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I REPLACE_IMPLICIT_VARIABLES    Replacing the Implicitly Used Variables                     .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I SET_CALLPACKAGE               Setting the Call Package                                    .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME               I SET_DATAOBJ                   Setting a Data Object                                       .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME_TYPE_0        I EXECUTE                       Execution of a Service of Type 1                            .
IF_RSISR_RUNTIME_TYPE_1        I EXECUTE                       Execution of a Service of Type 1                            .
IF_RSISR_SUMMARY_VIEWER        I DISPLAY_SUMMARY_RESULTS       Display Summary                                             .
IF_RSISR_VALUE_HELP            I GET_VALUE_HELP                Return of Names of Columns for the Data Object              .
IF_RSISR_WS_DATA_PROVIDER      I GET_DATA                      Returns the Retrieved Data                                  .
IF_RSMDS_CONDITION_RENDERER    I RENDER_NULL_CONDITION         Generate "IS NULL" Condtion                                 .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I CALCULATE_PREDECESSOR         Determine predecessor, if it exists                         .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I CALCULATE_SUCCESSOR           Determine successor, if it exists                           .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I CREATE_SET_FROM_RANGES        Generate One-Dimensional Set from RANGE Table               .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I CREATE_SORTED_TABLE_REF       Generate Table Reference from Input Table                   .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I DATA_TO_LITERAL               Convert Value to a Character-Literal Value                  .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I DATA_TO_STRING                Convert Internal Value to Character String                  .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_ALIAS                     Alias Name of Dimension                                     .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_MAXIMUM_REF               Determine Maximum                                           .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_MAXIMUM_SUCCESSOR         Returns a string representation of the maximum's successor  .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_MINIMUM_PREDECESSOR       Returns a string representation of the minimum's predecessor.
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_MINIMUM_REF               Determine Minimum                                           .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_NAME                      Unique Name of Dimension                                    .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I GET_TYPE                      Data Type of Dimension                                      .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I HAS_MAXIMUM                   Data Type Contains Maximum for Basic Set                    .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I HAS_MINIMUM                   Data Type Contains Minimum for Basic Set                    .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I IS_STRICTLY_MONOTONIC         Mapping to Target Dimension Is Strictly Monotone            .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I IS_TRANSFORMABLE              Mapping to Target Dimension is Possible                     .
IF_RSMDS_DIMENSION             I TRANSFORM_DIMENSION_SET_INTERNTransform One Dimensional Quantity to Target Dimension      .
IF_RSMDS_ORDERED               I COMPARE                       Determine Sequence of Two Objects                           .
IF_RSMDS_TYPE                  I GET_NAME                      Type Name                                                   .
IF_RSMDS_TYPE                  I TO_HASH_LITERAL               Converts a Value to a String for Hash Calculation           .
IF_RSMD_CONVERSION_HANDLER     I CHECK                         Consistency Check (Can Be Executed in Conversion)           .
IF_RSMD_CONVERSION_HANDLER     I IMPACT_ANALYSIS               Write Objects to be Checked/Converted into Appl. Log        .
IF_RSMD_CONVERSION_HANDLER     I RENAME                        Renaming of Characteristic Values (Special Case ALPHA Conv) .
IF_RSMD_CONVERSION_HANDLER     I RESET                         Deletes Content of Local Status Table (if Not Restarted)    .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I DELETE_VHS_PERS_VALUE_SET     Save the personlized values for value help services         .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I GET_VHS_PERS_VALUE_SET        To get the personalized values for the Value Help Service   .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I GET_VHS_PERS_VALUE_TEXT       To get the texts for the personal values                    .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I GET_VHS_USER_SETTINGS         Get  the various user settings needed for value help service.
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I SAVE_VHS_HISTORY_SET          Save the history values for value help services             .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I SAVE_VHS_PERS_VALUE_SET       Save the personlized values for value help services         .
IF_RSMD_PERS                   I SAVE_VHS_USER_SETTINGS        To save the user settings received from value help services .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_AUTH_MODE                 Get the previously set Authorisation Mode                   .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_DATE_SELECTION            Get the previously set date selection                       .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_FUZZY_SEARCH              String für Fuzzy Suche abfragen                             .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_INFOPROV_META_DATA        Get the previously meta data infoprovider                   .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_KEY_DATE                  Get the previously set key data                             .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_LANGU                     Get the previously set language for language dependant texts.
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_LANGU_SELECTION           Get language selection for language dependant texts         .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_MAX_ROWS                  Get the previously set maximal number of rows to be returned.
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_MOST_RECENT_FL            Returns the flag for most recent data                       .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_OLAP_INSTANCE             Olap Instanz abholen                                        .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_READ_MODE                 Returns the previously set F4-mode                          .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_REQUESTED_IOBJNMS         Get the previouly set requested attributes                  .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_SELECTION_SELDR           Get the previously set restricting SELDRs                   .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_SELECTION_SELOPT          Get the previously set restricting selection options        .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_SORTING                   Get the previously set Sorting                              .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I GET_SUPPORTED_READ_MODES      Returns the supported read modes                            .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I READ_DATA                     Read the data requested by the user                         .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I READ_META_DATA                Read the Meta Data of the infoobject requested by the user  .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_AUTH_MODE                 Set the Authorisation Mode for the user                     .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_DATE_SELECTION            Set a date selection (for time dependant attributes/texts)  .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_FUZZY_SEARCH              String für Fuzzy Suche übergeben                            .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_KEY_DATE                  Set the key date (for time dependant attributes/texts)      .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_LANGU_SELECTION           Set language selection for language dependant texts         .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_MAX_ROWS                  Set the maximal number of rows to be returned               .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_MOST_RECENT_FL            Sets the flag for the most recent data                      .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_OLAP_INSTANCE             Olap Instanz für Q-Mode setzen                              .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_READ_MODE                 Set the Read(F4)-mode: possible M,D,Q                       .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_REQUESTED_IOBJNMS         Set the Attributes/Compound Charac. requested by the user   .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_SELECTION_SELDR           Set the selection structure SELDRs                          .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_SELECTION_SELOPT          Set the selection option structure selopt                   .
IF_RSMD_RS                     I SET_SORTING                   Set the wished Sorting                                      .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_CHILDREN                  gets the childrens for a particular node of hierarchy       .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_HIERARCHIES               returns the details of the hierarchies of the info object   .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_INITIAL_NODES             reads the hierarchy node for info object                    .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_KEY_DATE                  returns the already set key date for the hierarchy          .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_NODEFROMKEY               gets the Node identifier for the node of hierarchy          .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_OLAP_INSTANCE             Olap Instanz abholen                                        .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_READ_MODE                 return the read mode set for instance                       .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_SEARCHTREE                gets the serach tree based on the selection search pattern  .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_SELDR                     returns the previously set seldr structure for the hierarchy.
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_SELECTIONSELOPT           gets previously set selection structure                     .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_SORTING                   gets the sorting structure set for the hierarchy            .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_STARTLEVEL                returns the level of nodes to be displayed at start set     .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_SUPPORTED_READ_MODES      Returns the supported read modes                            .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_TEXT_DATE                 returns the text date set for the instance                  .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I GET_WITH_REST_NODE            gets the previously set flag for fetching the rest node     .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I REINITIALIZE_HIERARCHY        reinitializes the hierarchy instance                        .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_KEY_DATE                  set the key date for the hierarchy instance                 .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_OLAP_INSTANCE             Olap Instanz für Q-Mode setzen                              .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_READ_MODE                 sets the read mode for the instance                         .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_SELDR                     sets the seldr structure for the hierarchy                  .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_SELECTIONSELOPT           sets selection structure based on which search is executed  .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_SORTING                   sets the sorting structure for the hierarchy                .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_STARTLEVEL                sets the level of drill down to be displayed at start       .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_TEXT_DATE                 sets the text date for the instance                         .
IF_RSMD_RSH                    I SET_WITH_REST_NODE            set the flag for fetching the rest node of the hierarchy    .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I CREATE                        Retruns the reference to itself                             .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns the attributes of the info object for given CHAVLS  .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I GET_CAPABILITIES              Fähigkeiten der Access-Klasse liefern                       .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I GET_TEXT                      This will return the text of the corresponding Chavls       .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I GET_VALUES                    This will returns the INFO OBJECTS values along with text   .
IF_RSMD_RS_ACCESS              I SET_KEY_DATE                  Sets the date for the instance                              .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I CREATE                        Create Instance                                             .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I RESTRICT_BY_AUTH_VALUES       -" O_R_WHERE_TREE (AND)                                     .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I RESTRICT_BY_INFOPROV          -" O_R_SUBSELECT (OR)                                       .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I RESTRICT_BY_NAV_ATTR          -" O_R_SUBSELECT (OR)                                       .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I RESTRICT_BY_RANGE             -" O_R_WHERE_TREE (AND)                                     .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I RESTRICT_BY_SELDR             -" O_R_WHERE_TREE (AND)                                     .
IF_RSMD_RS_BUILD_QUERY         I SET_SEARCH_STRING             Set Search String                                           .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I CHECK                         Check method                                                .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I CREATE                        Retruns the reference to itself                             .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I GET_PARAMETER                 To get the parameter structure                              .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I GET_PARAMETERSTRING           To get the parameter string                                 .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I GET_STRUCTURE_NAME            To get the structure name                                   .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I SET_PARAMETER                 To set the structure with values                            .
IF_RSMD_RS_GENERIC             I SET_PARAMETERSTRING           To set the attributes from the parameter string             .
IF_RSMD_USAGE_TYPE_UC          I EXECUTE                       Starts the masterdata usage check for the given object      .
IF_RSMD_USAGE_TYPE_UC          I GET_MASTER_DATA_USAGE_KEY     Return the masterdata usage key of the instance             .
IF_RSMD_USAGE_TYPE_UC          I GET_USING_OBJECTS             Returns instances for all BW objects that use given characte.
IF_RSMD_USAGE_TYPE_UC          I INITIALIZE_USING_OBJECT       Initialize the state of the using object                    .
IF_RSMD_USAGE_TYPE_UC          I RESET                         Reset state (for a restart of Usage Check)                  .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I CLEAR                         Delete Object Attributes                                    .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I GET_CUSTOM_OBJECT             Returns Object with Additional Properties                   .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I GET_PREDECESSOR               Supplies Link Source                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Supplies Link Target                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_CUSTOM_OBJECT             Sets Object with Additional Properties                      .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_PREDECESSOR               Set Source Link                                             .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Properties                                              .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK           I SET_SUCCESSOR                 Set Link Source                                             .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_LINK_INTERNAL  I GET_DATA_FOR_NETPLAN          Provides Link Structure                                     .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I CLEAR                         Delete Table Object Attributes                              .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I DELETE_ROW                    Delete Row in Table                                         .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I GET_CUSTOM_OBJECT             Returns Object with Additional Properties                   .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I GET_TABLEDATA                 Provides Data Table for Table Object                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I GET_TITLE                     Provides Table Title                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I INSERT_ROW                    Insert Row in Table                                         .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I IS_VISIBLE                    = True If Table Is Visible                                  .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_CELL_PROPERTIES           Set 2 Cell Properties                                       .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_COLUMN_PROPERTIES         Set 1 Column Properties                                     .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_CUSTOM_OBJECT             Set Object with Additional Properties                       .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_POSITION                  Sets Position of the Table                                  .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_ROW_PROPERTIES            Set 2 Row Properties                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_TABLEDATA                 Insert 1 Table Data                                         .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_TABLE_ATTRIBUTES          Set 1 Table Attributes                                      .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_TABLE_PROPERTIES          Set Table Properties                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_TABLE_STATUS              Set 1 Table Status                                          .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE          I SET_TITLE                     Set Table Title (Also Possible via Table Properties)        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERN   I FIRSTCALLDONE                 Sets P_FIRSTCALLDONE                                        .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERN   I GET_DATA_FOR_NETPLAN          Returns Tables for Network Update                           .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERNAL I GET_TABID                     Provides Table Object ID                                    .
IF_RSNETGRAPHIC_TABLE_INTERNAL I SET_STATUS                    Set Status                                                  .
IF_RSOBJS_CHANGE_NODES         I CHANGE_FAVORITES              Enhance Favorites                                           .
IF_RSOBJS_CHANGE_NODES         I CHANGE_HISTORY                Enhance History                                             .
IF_RSOBJS_CHANGE_NODES         I CHANGE_ROLES                  Enhance Roles                                               .
IF_RSOBJS_CHANGE_NODES         I CHANGE_SEARCH_RESULT          Enhance Search Result                                       .
IF_RSOBJS_CHANGE_NODES         I GET_CHILDREN                  Get Children for a Parent Node                              .
IF_RSOBJS_CHECK                I CHECK_OBJECT                  Check Object                                                .
IF_RSOBJS_CHILDREN             I GET_CHILDREN                  Provide Child Nodes for a Parent Node                       .
IF_RSOBJS_COMMON               I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check existence                                             .
IF_RSOBJS_COMMON               I GET_OBJECT_ATTRIBUTES         Provide Object Attributes                                   .
IF_RSOBJS_COMMON               I GET_PROPERTIES                Provide Properties                                          .
IF_RSOBJS_COMMON               I SEARCH_IN_NAMES               Search in Names                                             .
IF_RSOBJS_DELETE               I CHECK_AUTH_FOR_DELETE         Checks Before Deletion                                      .
IF_RSOBJS_DELETE               I CHECK_ENQUEUE_FOR_DELETE      Check Whether the Object Is Lockable                        .
IF_RSOBJS_DELETE               I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object                                               .
IF_RSOBJS_EXTENDEDTYPES        I GET_MOST_DETAIL_TYPE          Get Correct Object Type for Saving                          .
IF_RSOBJS_EXTENDEDTYPES        I GET_RELATED_TYPES             Get Multiple Object Types While Reading                     .
IF_RSOBJS_FOLDERS              I GET_FOLDERS                   Individual Hierarchical View of the Object                  .
IF_RSOBJS_GENERAL              I GET_PROPERTIES                Properties of the Selected Object                           .
IF_RSOBJS_GENERAL              I SEARCH                        Search Using Your Own Modules                               .
IF_RSOBJS_GENERAL              I WHERE_USED_LIST               Provide Where-Used List                                     .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I CHECK_AUTH_FOR_CREATE         Check Authorizations for Creating                           .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I CHECK_AUTH_FOR_DELETE         Check Authorizations for Deleting                           .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I CHECK_USER_LOCKS              Check User Locks (for Saving and Deleting)                  .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object                                               .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I GET_WHERE_USED_LIST           Get Where-Used List                                         .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I MISC_CHECK_FOR_CREATE         Other Checks for Creating (Optional)                        .
IF_RSOBJS_MAINTAIN             I MISC_CHECK_FOR_DELETE         Other Checks for Deleting (Optional)                        .
IF_RSOBJS_PFCG                 I GET_LAUNCH_URL                Get Launch URL (Only for URL_TYPE Objects)                  .
IF_RSOBJS_SAVE                 I CHANGE_URL                    Change the URL Before Saving                                .
IF_RSOBJS_SAVE                 I CHECK_AUTH_FOR_SAVE           Authorization for Saving the Object                         .
IF_RSOBJS_SAVE                 I CHECK_ENQUEUE_FOR_SAVE        Check Whether the Object Lockable Before Saving             .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I CHANGE_PROPERTY               Changes the value from properties and/or the search string  .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I CHECK_LOIO_PROPERTIES         Check LOIO Properties in Dialog                             .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I DOCUMENTS_EXIST               Do documents exist for the context?                         .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_AUTHORITY_STATE           Delivers the status for the authorization check             .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Delivers the description of the context                     .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_DOCUMENT                  Returns A Document                                          .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_DOCUMENTS                 Returns the documents                                       .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_DOCUMENT_CLASS            Delivers the BW Document Class (META, MAST, TRAN)           .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_ITEM                      Delivers the Current Web Item or NULL                       .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_LOIO_CLASS                Delivers the LOIO Document Class for CM                     .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_PHIO_CLASS                Delivers the PHIO Document Class for CM                     .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_PROPERTIES_FIX            Delivers the Fixed Properties / the Filter (Ranges)         .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_PROPERTIES_FOR_DISPLAY    Delivers (Not Unique) Properties for Displaying             .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_PROPERTIES_SELECTION      Delivers the Properties for the Changes to the Selection    .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_PROPERTY_INFO             Delivers Info.for a Property in Context of the LOIO Class   .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_SEARCH_PARAMETERS         Delivers Parameter for Text Search                          .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_TRANSPORT_INFOS           Delivers the Transport Entries for the Object               .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_URL                       Delivers the URL for the Document Browser                   .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I GET_VALUES_FOR_PROPERTY       Delivers all the Values of a Property                       .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I IS_INITIAL                    = 'X':Context Is Still Blank                                .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I REFRESH                       Force Re-reading of Documents                               .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I SET_ITEM                      Set Current Web Item                                        .
IF_RSOD_CONTEXT                I SET_URL_ADRESSING             Sets Address Mode - DocBrowser URLS (Absolute/Relative)     .
IF_RSOD_DOCU_URL_HANDLER       I ESCAPE                        Escape URL                                                  .
IF_RSOD_DOCU_URL_HANDLER       I MODIFY_DOCUMENT_URL           Modify a URL for a Document                                 .
IF_RSOD_DOCU_URL_HANDLER       I MODIFY_ICON_URL               Modify a URL for an Icon                                    .
IF_RSOD_DOCU_URL_HANDLER       I MODIFY_OBJECT_URL             Modify the URL for a Meta Object                            .
IF_RSOD_DOCU_URL_HANDLER       I MODIFY_STYLESHEET_URL         Modify the URL for a Style Sheet                            .
IF_RSOD_DOC_MAINT_CALLER       I GET_DOCUMENT                  Gets Reference to Current Document                          .
IF_RSOD_DOC_MAINT_CALLER       I GET_DOCUMENT_CLASS            Gets Document Class                                         .
IF_RSOD_DOC_MAINT_CALLER       I GET_ON_CLOSE_URL              Gets URL To Be Called Up On Close (0DOC_TEMPLATE)           .
IF_RSOD_DOC_MAINT_CALLER       I GET_PROPERTIES                Gets Properties (Selection of Item)                         .
IF_RSOD_DOC_MAINT_CALLER       I REFRESH                       Document Changed -" Render Anew                             .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I CREATE_RESOURCE               Create a Resource                                           .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I DELETE                        Deliver Properties of a Resource                            .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Delete Properties of a Resource                             .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I GET_CHILDREN                  Return Lower Levels of a Directory                          .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I GET_CONTENT                   Delivers Contents of a Document                             .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I GET_PROPERTIES                Deliver Properties of a Resource                            .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I GET_RESOURCE_BY_URL           Delivers a Resource from a URL                              .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I GET_ROOT_CHILDREN             Return Root Objects                                         .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I LOCK_RESOURCE                 Lock Resource                                               .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I QUERY                         Resource Search Using Properties                            .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I RENAME_RESOURCE               Rename Resource                                             .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I RESOURCE_IS_LOCKED            Resource Locked ?                                           .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I SET_CONTENT                   Sets the Contents of a Document (Not a New Version)         .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Properties of a Resource                                .
IF_RSOD_SKWF_RM                I UNLOCK_RESOURCE               Unlock Resource                                             .
IF_RSORA_SQL_HINT              I CHANGE_HINT                   Change Proposed Hint if Necessary                           .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds a Message to the Application Log                       .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGES_AS_STRUCTURE     Adds Several Messages (as Structures) to the Application Log.
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGES_LEVEL            Adds Several Messages to the Applictn Log and Sets the Level.
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGES_OF_EXCEPTION     Adds Messages after Catching an Exception                   .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGE_AS_STRUCTURE      Adds Message (as Structure) to the Application Log          .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_MESSAGE_LEVEL             Adds Message to the Application Log with Detail Level       .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I ADD_TEXT                      Adds a Text to the Application Log                          .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_CREATE               Generated a New Application Log                             .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_DELETE               Deletes Current Application Log                             .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_DELETE_ON_DB         Deletes Log on the Database                                 .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_DSP_MSG_LONGTEXT     Displays Long Text of a Message                             .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_GET_LOG_HANDLE       Handel for the Current Application Log                      .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_GET_NUM_OF_MSGS      Number of Messages in the Current Applicatoin Log           .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_MSG_READ             Reads the Messages in the Current Application Log           .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_SAVE                 Saves Current Application Log to Database                   .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_SET_TITLE            Set the Title of the Log (Used Next Time Log is Generated)  .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_SHOW_AS_POPUP        Displays the Application Log as a Dialog Box                .
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I APPL_LOG_SHOW_WITH_SELECTION  Displays the Application Log of the DB (withSelectionScreen).
IF_RSO_APPLICATION_LOG         I INSERT_MESSAGES_INTO_DOM      Add Messages in XML DOM                                     .
IF_RSO_ASSOCIATION             I INSERT_ASSOCIATIONS           Adding a List of Associations to an Object                  .
IF_RSO_ASSOCIATION             I READ_ALL_OBJ_OF_OBJ           Restores all Objects associated with an Object              .
IF_RSO_ASSOCIATION             I SHOW_ALL_ASSOCIATIONS_AS_LIST Displays all Associations in List (ALV)                     .
IF_RSO_CONTENT_WIZARD          I CONTENT_ACTIVATE              Transfer and Activate Content Objects (Simulation poss.)    .
IF_RSO_CONTENT_WIZARD          I CONTENT_WIZARD                Install Business Content                                    .
IF_RSO_CONTENT_WIZARD          I SET_CHECKBOX                  Sets Checkbox in Tree                                       .
IF_RSO_CWM                     I EXPORT                        Export Objects in CWM Format as File                        .
IF_RSO_CWM                     I EXPORT_COLLECT                Collect Objects for Export (CWM)                            .
IF_RSO_CWM                     I IMPORT                        Process Imported CWM File                                   .
IF_RSO_CWM                     I IMPORT_COLLECT                Collect Objects from Import CWM                             .
IF_RSO_IMPACT_ANALYSIS         I IMPACT_ANALYSIS               Impact Analysis                                             .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I COMPOSE_HYPERLINK             Create Hyperlink                                            .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_ARC                      Draw Arc                                                    .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_GRAPHICS_EPILOG          Epilog for Graphic                                          .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_GRAPHICS_PROLOG          Prolog for Graphic                                          .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_LINE                     Draw Line/Arrow                                             .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_RECT_END                 Rectangle (XML: End Tag)                                    .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_RECT_START               Rectangle (XML: Introductory Tag)                           .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I DRAW_TEXT                     Output Text                                                 .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I HYPERLINK_DECODE              Decode Hyperlink (~ -"  space ...)                          .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NETWORK_DRAW     I HYPERLINK_ENCODE              Decode Hyperlink (~ -"  space ...)                          .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I ARRANGE                       Sort Subobjects                                             .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I DRAW                          Draw Subobjects and Self                                    .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I GET_DOCK_POS_OF_OBJECT        Returns Object Positions for Lines                          .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I INSERT_ASSOCIATION            Adds an Association between Objects                         .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I INSERT_OBJECT                 Adds an Object                                              .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_NET_COMPONENT    I SET_ASC_DRAW_PARAMETERS       Additional Parameters to Draw Associations                  .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_SERVICES         I F4_MULTI_TLOGO                F4 Help for Objects with Multiple Selection                 .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_SERVICES         I F4_TLOGO                      F4 Help for Objects (Native)                                .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_SERVICES         I F4_TLOGO_ALL                  F4 Help - All Objects of all TLOGO Types                    .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_SERVICES         I MAINTAIN_OBJECT               Calls Object Maintenance                                    .
IF_RSO_OBJECT_SERVICES         I SHOW_DOCU_BDS                 Displays Object Documents (using BDS)                       .
IF_RSO_RENDER_HTML             I RENDER                        Create HTML                                                 .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_BROWSER      I REPOSITORY_BROWSER            Repository Browser                                          .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT       I GET_ASSOCIATED_OBJECTS        Restore all References of Associated Objects                .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT       I GET_DOCUMENTS_OF_OBJECT       Returns Document IDs for a BW Object                        .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT       I GET_PROPERTIES                Restore Properties for Certain Versions                     .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_WRITE I INITIALIZE                    Initializng the Proxy (Replaces Constructor with Parameters).
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_WRITE I INSERT_ASSOCIATION_REF        Adds an Object-relevant Association                         .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_XML   I XML_EXPORT_OBJECT             Returns Metadata for an Object in CWM (XML)                 .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_XML   I XML_IMPORT_ACTIVATE_ALL       Activates All Objects of a Type (XML_..._SINGLE)            .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_XML   I XML_IMPORT_ACTIVATE_SINGLE    Activates the Objects Individually (XML_IMPORT_SAVE)        .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_XML   I XML_IMPORT_PARSE              Parse this Object from CWM DOM                              .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_OBJECT_XML   I XML_IMPORT_SAVE               Saves the Object (XML_IMPORT_PARSE)                         .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_XML          I EXPORT_METAMODEL_RESOURCES    Resources-Strings for BW Metamodel im XMI Format            .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_XML          I XML_EXPORT_METAMODEL          Displays the BW Metamodel in XMI Format                     .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_XML          I XML_EXPORT_OBJECT             Returns Object-Metadata as CWM                              .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_XML          I XML_EXPORT_OBJECTS            Returns Metadata for Objects as CWM                         .
IF_RSO_REPOSITORY_XML          I XML_IMPORT                    Import and Activate Objects from CWM Files                  .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_EXECUTABLE        I EXECUTE                       Execute / Start / Schedule... Object                        .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I ACTIVATE_CONTENT              Obsolete. Use IF_RSD_TLOGO_MAINTAIN-"BUILD_CONTENT_VERSION  .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I CHECK_FOR_DEEP_COPY           Consistency Check for Deep Copy / Clone                     .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I DEEP_COPY                     Deep Copy / Clone                                           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I EXISTS_ON_DB                  Determines whether Object Exists in Database                .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I GET_ALL                       Return All the Objects in a Version                         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I GET_INSTANCE                  Delivers a Reference (Type IF_RSO_TLOGO) for the Object     .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I GET_PROPERTIES                Determines General Object Properties                        .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I GET_RELATED                   Determines Related Objects                                  .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I IMPACT_ANALYSIS               Reaction to Changes Made to a Dependent TLOGO Object        .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I MAINTAIN_GUI                  Call of Object Maintenance (optional)                       .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I NEW_DEP_BCT                   Obsolete! Dependent Objs. from Switching On BCT Component   .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I SHOW_DOCUMENTS                Obsolete! Display Documents for Object (Optional)           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_GENERAL           I SHOW_VERSION_COMPARISON       Display Comparison of Two Object Versions (Optional)        .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I ACTIVATE                      Optional  -" CL_RSO_TLOGO_COLLECTION-"ACTIVATE              .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I BUILD_CONTENT                 Build (Copy/Merge) Content Version as Temp. N Version       .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I CHECK                         Carry Out Consistency Checks                                .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivate object                                           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I DELETE                        Optional -" CL_RSO_TLOGO_COLLECTION-"DELETE                 .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I DEQUEUE                       Unlock                                                      .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I GET_MAINTENANCE_STATE         Returns the Processing Status of the Object                 .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I IS_ACTIVE                     Checks whether object is active (meaning A = M Version)     .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I IS_SAVED                      Checks whether object is saved                              .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I PREPARE                       Prepare Editing (Locks, CTO Check, Authorization)           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I RESET_TO_ACTIVE               Reset Object to Active Version (only for M version)         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I SAVE                          Optional -" CL_RSO_TLOGO_COLLECTION-"SAVE                   .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I SET_MAINTENANCE_STATE         Sets the Processing Status of the Object                    .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I SET_OBJSTAT                   Set Object Status                                           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I SHOW_PROTOCOL                 Optional  -" Display Database Log (Application Log)         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN          I VERSION_EXISTS                Checks if the Version Exists                                .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I AFTER_ACTIVATION              Actions After DDIC Activation(Before Activtng Table Entries).
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I AFTER_ACTIVATION_DB           Activities After Activation of Metadata on the Database     .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I AFTER_DDIC_SAVE               Optional: Perform DB-Specific Operation after "Save DDic"   .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I AFTER_DELETION                Actions After Deletion of Sources                           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I BEFORE_ACTIVATION             Actions Before Activation of DDIC                           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I BEFORE_DELETION               Actions Before Deletion in DDIC                             .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I COPY_VERSION                  Copy Versions                                               .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I GET_DDIC_OBJECTS              Return Affected DDIC Objects (and save where necessary)     .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_MAINTAIN_INT      I SAVE_INTERNAL                 Save Internal (Save the N Version)                          .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_PROPERTIES        I GET_TLOGOPROP                 Restore Properties of Type TLOGO                            .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_PROPERTIES        I GET_TLOGO_DESCRIPTION         Restores Description of Type TLOGO                          .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_PROPERTIES        I GET_TLOGO_ICON                Restores Icon of Type TLOGO                                 .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_PROPERTIES        I GET_TLOGO_ICON_WEB_ID         Restores ID of Type TLOGO (Web Repository)                  .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_SEARCH            I GET_SEARCH_ATTRIBUTES         Supplies values of the search attributes (RSOTLOGOSEARATR)  .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_SOURSYS_DEPENDENT I GET_PSEUDO_DVERSION           Returns Pseudo D Versions for Shadow Object                 .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_SOURSYS_DEPENDENT I GET_WRITE_SHADOW              Determining (or Writing) Shadow Object/Delivery Object      .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_SOURSYS_DEPENDENT I PSEUDO_DVERSION_DELETE        Deletion of Pseudo D Versions                               .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_SOURSYS_DEPENDENT I PSEUDO_DVERSION_WRITE         Writing of Pseudo D Versions from Shadow Versions           .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_TRANSPORT         I CTO_AFTER_SAVE_ACT_DEL        Check After Saving/Activating/Deleting an Object            .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_TRANSPORT         I CTO_CHECK                     Check Transport Before Starting Maintenance                 .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_TRANSPORT         I CTO_GET_ADDITIONAL_OBJECTS    Does not return BW objects that must be transported         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_TRANSPORT         I CTO_INSERT                    Write Object to Request Before Save                         .
IF_RSO_TLOGO_TRANSPORT         I CTO_TRANSPORT                 Manually Write Object to a Request                          .
IF_RSO_TRANSLATION             I TRANSLATE                     Translate Selected Objects                                  .
IF_RSO_TRANSLATION             I TRANSLATION_TOOL              Translation Tool - Collect Objects                          .
IF_RSO_TRANSPORT_WIZARD        I COLLECT_ALL_OF_OBJECT         Collects All Association Objects for an Object              .
IF_RSO_TRANSPORT_WIZARD        I TRANSPORT_OBJECTS             Write Selected Objects to Transport Order                   .
IF_RSO_TRANSPORT_WIZARD        I TRANSPORT_WIZARD              Transport Connection                                        .
IF_RSO_TREE                    I TREE_INSERT                   Enters Data in Tree Display                                 .
IF_RSO_TREE                    I TREE_UPDATE                   Updates Data in the Tree Display                            .
IF_RSPC_ACTIVATE               I ACTIVATE                      Chain will be activated                                     .
IF_RSPC_ACTIVATE               I DELETE                        Chain was deleted                                           .
IF_RSPC_ACTIVATE               I UNSCHEDULE                    Chain was removed from schedule                             .
IF_RSPC_CALL_MONITOR           I CALL_MONITOR                  Calling a Customer's Monitoring-Tool                        .
IF_RSPC_CHECK                  I CHECK                         Check Current Scheduling of the Process                     .
IF_RSPC_CHECK                  I GIVE_ALL                      All Processes in the System                                 .
IF_RSPC_CONTEXTMENU            I MENU_REQUEST                  Context Menu Requests                                       .
IF_RSPC_CONTEXTMENU            I MENU_SELECT                   Executing the Selected Command                              .
IF_RSPC_EVENT_RESOLUTION       I GET_CATEGORY                  Determination of Alert Category                             .
IF_RSPC_EXECUTE                I EXECUTE                       Execute Process                                             .
IF_RSPC_EXECUTE                I GIVE_CHAIN                    The whole chain (i_t_processlist)                           .
IF_RSPC_GET_DEFAULT_CHAIN      I GET_DEFAULT_CHAIN             Minimum chain, in which a process is scheduled (default)    .
IF_RSPC_GET_INFO               I GET_INFO                      Passing on of information to subsequent process / management.
IF_RSPC_GET_INFO               I RUNTIME_PARAMETERS            Declaration of the Runtime Parameters                       .
IF_RSPC_GET_LOG                I DELETE_LOG                    Delete log                                                  .
IF_RSPC_GET_LOG                I GET_LOG                       Deliver Log                                                 .
IF_RSPC_GET_STATUS             I GET_STATUS                    Determine Current Status                                    .
IF_RSPC_GET_VARIANT            I EXISTS                        Check whether variants exist                                .
IF_RSPC_GET_VARIANT            I GET_VARIANT                   Get Variant                                                 .
IF_RSPC_GET_VARIANT            I WILDCARD_ENABLED              Wildcard Selection Possible                                 .
IF_RSPC_MAINTAIN               I GET_HEADER                    Determining the Header Information for the Variant          .
IF_RSPC_MAINTAIN               I MAINTAIN                      Maintaining a Process Variant                               .
IF_RSPC_MULTI_EVENT            I GET_EVENT                     Event Text                                                  .
IF_RSPC_MULTI_EVENT            I GET_EVENTS                    Setting Possible Events                                     .
IF_RSPC_RESTARTABILITY         I RESTART_IN_DIALOG             Does restart have to take place in the dialog?              .
IF_RSPC_SIMULATION             I DATA                          Disclosure of Results                                       .
IF_RSPC_SIMULATION             I POSSIBLE                      Is Simulation Possible?                                     .
IF_RSPC_SIMULATION             I SHOW                          Display of Results                                          .
IF_RSPC_TRANSPORT              I GET_TLOGO                     Getting the TLOGO Name                                      .
IF_RSPC_TRANSPORT              I KEY_CHANGE                    Possible Key Change after Import (Optional)                 .
IF_RSPC_VARIABLES              I GET_ALLOWED                   Determination of Permissible Variables                      .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_INFOPROV                  Returns the InfoProvider Name                               .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_TAB_IOBJ_CMP              Get Compound Information for InfoObject                     .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_TAB_IOBJ_PRO              Get General Properties of InfoObjects                       .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_T_CHARNM                  Returns Names of All the InfoProvider Characteristics       .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_T_KEYFNM                  Returns Names of All the InfoProvider Key Figures           .
IF_RSPLFA_INFOPROV_DESC        I GET_VALIDITY_DATE             Deliver Validity Date for Planning                          .
IF_RSPLFA_MSG                  I ADD_MSG                       Add Current Message (from System Fields)                    .
IF_RSPLFA_MSG_PARAM_CHECK      I ADD_MSG_WITH_PARAM_CONTEXT    Add Current Message and Parameter Context                   .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_DATA_SEL       I GET_T_SEL                     Get Selection Table                                         .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_ELEM           I GET_VALUE                     Get Value (Type-Related)                                    .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_IOBJ           I GET_IOBJNM                    Get InfoObject Name                                         .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_KEYF_SEL       I GET_T_KEYFNM                  Get Names of Selected Key Figures                           .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_PARAM_DATA_SEL            Get Data-Selection Parameter                                .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_PARAM_ELEM                Get Elementary Parameters                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_PARAM_IOBJ                Get InfoObject Parameter                                    .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_PARAM_KEYF_SEL            Get Key-Figure-Selection Parameter                          .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_PARAM_STRUC               Get Structured Parameters                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_RULEPOS                   Get Position (ID) of Corresponding Rule                     .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_TAB_PARAM_DATA_SEL        Get Table of Data Selection Parameter Values                .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_TAB_PARAM_ELEM            Get Table of Elementary Parameter Values                    .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_TAB_PARAM_IOBJ            Get Table of InfoObject Parameter Values                    .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_SET            I GET_TAB_PARAM_STRUC           Get Table of Structured Parameters                          .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_STRUC          I GET_COMP_DATA_SEL             Get Components of Type: Data Selection Parameter            .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_STRUC          I GET_COMP_ELEM                 Get Components of Type: Elementary Parameter                .
IF_RSPLFA_PARAM_STRUC          I GET_COMP_IOBJ                 Get Components of Type: InfoObject Parameter                .
IF_RSPLFA_PLAN_BUFFER          I GET_DATA                      Read Data from Buffer                                       .
IF_RSPLFA_PLAN_BUFFER          I GET_INSTANCE                  Generate Instance on Basis of IF_RSPLFA_PLAN_BUFFER         .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_ADMIN_INFO                Get Administration Information                              .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_INFOPROV                  Get Name of InfoProvider                                    .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_NAME                      Get Name (ID)                                               .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_PARAM_SET_RULES           Get Rules with All Parameter Records                        .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_SRVTYPENM                 Get Name of Function Type                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_TAB_CHAR_USAGE            Get Table of Usages of Characteristic                       .
IF_RSPLFA_SRV                  I GET_TEXT                      Get Text (in Log-On Language)                               .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_CHAR_USAGE_LAYOUT         Get Layout of Characteristic Usage                          .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_HAS_REF_DATA              Get Indicator Showing If Reference Data Is Required         .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_IMPL_CLASSNM              Get Class Name of Implementation                            .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_NAME                      Get Name (ID)                                               .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_PARAM_SET                 Get Parameter Record (Definition of Parameter)              .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_TEXT                      Get Text                                                    .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_DEF          I GET_WD_DIALOG_INFO            Get Dialog Information for Web Dynpro                       .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_CHECK    I CHECK_CHAR_USAGE              Characteristic Usage Check                                  .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_CHECK    I CHECK_PARAM_SET               Parameter Record Check                                      .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_CHECK    I INIT_CHECK                    Initialization for Checks                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC     I EXECUTE                       Execution                                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC     I FINISH_EXECUTION              Actions at End of Execution                                 .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC     I INIT_EXECUTION                Initialization for Execution                                .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC_REF I ADD_NEW_BLOCKS                Add New Blocks                                              .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC_REF I EXECUTE                       Execution                                                   .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC_REF I FINISH_EXECUTION              Actions at End of Execution                                 .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC_REF I GET_REF_DATA_SEL              Determine Selection for Reference Data                      .
IF_RSPLFA_SRVTYPE_IMP_EXEC_REF I INIT_EXECUTION                Initialization for Execution                                .
IF_RSPLFR_SRVTYPE_ADD_VAR      I GET_VARIABLES                 Fetch Additional Variables from a Parameter Record          .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I CHECK                         PPM Object Check                                            .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I CHECK_EXIST                   Check Whether Object Exists in Master Data                  .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I DELETE_CHASEL                 Delete: Assigned Selection                                  .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I DELETE_FROM_BUFFER            Delete: Entry from Buffer                                   .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I DELETE_MASTERDATA             Delete: Master Data                                         .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I GET_CHARS_FROM_CHASEL         Get: Characteristics in Characteristic Selection            .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I GET_CHASEL                    Get: Selection for Object                                   .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I GET_MASTERDATA                Get: Master Data Attributes                                 .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I MODIFY_MASTERDATA_IN_BUF      Update: Master Data Attributes in Buffer                    .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I SAVE_CHASEL                   Save: Assigned Selection                                    .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I SAVE_MASTERDATA               Save: Master Data                                           .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I SET_CHASEL_IN_BUF             Set/Overwrite: Selection in Buffer                          .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS          I SET_MASTERDATA_IN_BUF         Set/Overwrite: Master Data Attributes in Buffer             .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DB       I PREPARE_MD_DELETE             Structure of Deletion Criteria for Master Data              .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DB       I PREPARE_MD_READ               Structure of Selection Criteria for Master Data Read Access .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DB       I PREPARE_MD_SAVE               Structure of Save Criteria for Master Data                  .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DSO      I PREPARE_DSO_DELETE            Structure of Deletion Criteria for DataStoreObject Data     .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DSO      I PREPARE_DSO_READ              Structure of Selection Criteria for DataStoreObject Data    .
IF_RSPLPPM_PPMOBJECTS_DSO      I PREPARE_DSO_SAVE              Structure of Save Criteria for DataStoreObject Data         .
IF_RSPLS_CHAR_RELATION         I CREATE_DATA_REF               Generate Data Reference to Characteristic Structure         .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I CHECK                         Check Combination of Characteristics                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I CLEAR_EXT_VAL                 Deletes Records of Last Validation                          .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I COLLECT                       Collects Records for Substitution/Validation                .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I CREATE                        Generate Characteristic Combinations                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I CREATE_CONTEXT                Generate a Context for Block Processing                     .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I DERIVE                        Derive Chars. (Source and Target Chars. in Structure)       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I EXTEND_VALIDATE               Performs the Substitution/Validation                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I FREE                          Release All Instances                                       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I FREE_INSTANCE                 Release an Instance                                         .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I GET_CHA_KEY                   Provide the Characteristic Value from the Data Record       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I GET_DS_USE_UNION              Gets P_DS_USE_UNION Indicator                               .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I GET_INSTANCE                  Factory Method                                              .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I GET_PARTPROV                  Determine Part Provider and Check If Embedding Is Possible  .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I GET_RELATED_CHAS              Fills Characteristics from Relations                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I HAS_DATA_SLICE                The characteristic tauch is used in a data slice            .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I HAS_REAL_RELATION             There are real characteristic relationships for this char   .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I IS_PROTECTED                  Check Whether a Data Record Is Locked Against Changes       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_AUTO_VALID_CHK            Change Indicator for Automatically Valid Combinations       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_CONTEXT                   Set a Context for Block Processing                          .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_DS_USE_UNION              Sets P_DS_USE_UNION Indicator                               .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_SELECTION                 Use Data Slices That Overlap with Selection                 .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_SUB_STRUCTURE             Block Processing: Determine Subset of Scope for Check       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I SET_UNIVERSE                  Determine Scope of Check, for example Aggregation Level     .
IF_RSPLS_CR_CONTROLLER         I UNSET_SELECTION               Activate All Data Slices                                    .
IF_RSPLS_CR_EXIT               I GET_INSTANCE                  Generate Instances Using Factory                            .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I CHECKM                        Check Combination of Characteristics                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I CHECKP                        Check Combination of Characteristics (Partial)              .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I CLEAR_EXT_VAL                 Deletes Records of Last Validation                          .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I COLLECT                       Collects Records for Substitution/Validation                .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I CREATEM                       Generate Characteristic Combinations                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I CREATE_CONTEXT                Generate a Context for Block Processing                     .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I DERIVEM                       Derive Chars. (Source and Target Chars. in Structure)       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I EXTEND_VALIDATE               Performs Validation/Substitution                            .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I GET_INSTANCE                  Generate a Mapper                                           .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I SET_CONTEXT                   Set a Context for Block Processing                          .
IF_RSPLS_CR_MAPPER             I SET_UNIVERSE                  Set Scope of Check                                          .
IF_RSPLS_CR_METHODS            I CHECK                         Check Combination of Characteristics                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_METHODS            I CREATE                        Generate Characteristic Combinations                        .
IF_RSPLS_CR_METHODS            I DERIVE                        Derive Chars. (Source and Target Chars. in Structure)       .
IF_RSPLS_CR_SPECIAL            I CHECKP                        Combination Check, Only on Some Characteristics             .
IF_RSPLS_DATASLICE             I CREATE_DATA_REF               Generate Data Reference to Data Record Structure            .
IF_RSPLS_DS_EXIT               I GET_INSTANCE                  Generate Instances Using Factory                            .
IF_RSPLS_DS_METHODS            I IS_OVERLAPPING                Check Whether a Selection Overlaps with Data Slices         .
IF_RSPLS_DS_METHODS            I IS_PROTECTED                  Check Whether a Data Record Is Locked Against Changes       .
IF_RSPLS_EV_METHODS            I EXTEND_VALIDATE               Performs the Substitution/Validation                        .
IF_RSPLS_EXTEND_VALIDATE       I CREATE_DATA_REF               Generate Data Reference to Data Record Structure            .
IF_RSPLS_MESG                  I CLEAR                         Delete Messages                                             .
IF_RSPLS_MESG                  I GET_COLLECT_MODE              Read Collection Mode                                        .
IF_RSPLS_MESG                  I GET_DATA_REF                  Generate Data Reference to New Message Table                .
IF_RSPLS_MESG                  I GET_MESG                      Read Messages                                               .
IF_RSPLS_MESG                  I SET_COLLECT_MODE              Set Collection Mode                                         .
IF_RSPV_REFERENCES             I CHANGE_VARIANT                Change Variant Before Activation                            .
IF_RSPV_TRANSPORT              I AFTER_IMPORT                  Transport subsequent Processing                             .
IF_RSPV_TRANSPORT              I GET_ADDITIONAL_OBJECTS        Find Related Non-BW Objects                                 .
IF_RSPV_TRANSPORT              I GET_RELATED                   Find Related Objects                                        .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I COLLAPSE_ALL                  Collapse tree                                               .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I DELETE_ALL_NODES              Delete all Nodes                                            .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I EXPAND_ALL                    Expand tree                                                 .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I FREE                          Clean up                                                    .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I GET_SELECTED_ITEM             Returns Marked Entry                                        .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I RAISE_ADD_TOBJ                Trigger Event                                               .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I REFRESH_DATA                  Reload Tree Data                                            .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SEARCH                        Search in tree                                              .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SEARCH_MORE                   Find Next                                                   .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SET_MODE                      Display "-" Change                                          .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SET_VISIBLE                   Switch Visible                                              .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SHOW                          Display of Data                                             .
IF_RSQ_ISET_TREE               I SORT                          Sort                                                        .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I CHANGE_BC_SETTING             Changes Setting Immediately after Reading Database          .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I CHANGE_URL_PARAMETER          Change the URL Parameter before Generating HTML Page in RA  .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I COPY_MIME_TO_FOLDER           Copies Object from MIME Repository to The Specified Folder  .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I CREATE_LOIO_IN_FOLDER         Generates New LOIO                                          .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I CREATE_PHIO_FOR_LOIO          Generates Physical Document for Logical Document            .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I DISSEMINATION_START           Distributes Transferred Documents                           .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I DO_COLLECT_SKWF_DOCUMENTS     BC Engine to Generate Documents in SKWF                     .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I FINALIZE                      Engine BC is Deleted                                        .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I GET_INDEX_PAGE_PARAMETER      Reads Parameter for Display on the Index Page               .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I INITIALIZE                    Engine BC is Instantiated                                   .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I SET_ALERT_LEVEL_FREQUENCY     Alert Level Frequency for LOIO                              .
IF_RSRA_BC_REMOTE_CONTROL      I SET_AUTHORIZATION             Authorization Information for LOIO                          .
IF_RSRA_MDX_REMOTE_CONTROL     I GET_MX_SETTING                Read the Definition of the MDX Setting                      .
IF_RSRD_CALLBACK_PROP_RENDERER I GET_HTML_VALUE_HELP           Change HTML Code for Input Help                             .
IF_RSRD_FILTER_DIALOG_PROVIDER I GET_CHARACTERISTIC            Determines Characteristic and InfoProvider for Index        .
IF_RSRD_FILTER_DIALOG_PROVIDER I GET_PARAMETER_QUERY           Delivers Parameter Container for Structuring Temporary Query.
IF_RSRD_FILTER_DIALOG_PROVIDER I SET_FILTER_STRING             Transfer of Filter String                                   .
IF_RSRD_F_BASE_OBJECT          I GET_INFO                      Determine Information for Object                            .
IF_RSRD_F_BASE_OBJECT          I GET_URL                       Generate URL onto Object                                    .
IF_RSRD_F_CONVERTER_RT         I CONVERT                       Convert                                                     .
IF_RSRD_F_CONVERTER_RT         I FINALIZE                      Clear                                                       .
IF_RSRD_F_CONVERTER_RT         I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_RSRD_F_DESIGN_TIME          I CHECK                         Checks parameter                                            .
IF_RSRD_F_DESIGN_TIME          I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get description of the attribute                            .
IF_RSRD_F_DESIGN_TIME          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUES          Calculation of attribute values for an attribute            .
IF_RSRD_F_DESIGN_TIME          I GET_VERSION                   Delivers Version of Attribute Description of Producer/Distr..
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I DISTRIBUTE                    Distribute                                                  .
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I FILTER_FOR_USER_LANGUAGE      Filters Parameters for Processsing a Particular User/Lang.  .
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I FINALIZE                      Clear                                                       .
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I GET_LANGUAGE_USER_COMBINATIONSDelivers Required Language/User Combinations (Sorted)       .
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I GET_RECIPIENT_LIST            Delivers Recipients for Recipient-Specific Creation of Docs .
IF_RSRD_F_DISTRIBUTOR_RT       I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_RSRD_F_PRODUCER_RT          I FINALIZE                      Clear                                                       .
IF_RSRD_F_PRODUCER_RT          I INITIALIZE                    Initialize                                                  .
IF_RSRD_F_PRODUCER_RT          I PRODUCE                       Creates Document                                            .
IF_RSRD_XML_PRODUCER           I GET_TEXT_VARIABLES            Determines XML-based Text Variables                         .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I CREATE                        Create Instance                                             .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I DEQUEUE                       Remove Locks                                                .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I ENQUEUE                       Set Locks                                                   .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I FREE                          Delete Instance                                             .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I GET_DATA_FOR_ARCHIVING        Get Data for Writing to Archive                             .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I PUT_DATA_FOR_RELOAD           Transfer Data for Load from Archive                         .
IF_RSREQARCH                   I WRITE_SUMMARY_RECORDS         Write Totals Records                                        .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I CREATE_INSTANCE               Generates Instance for BI Query                             .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I SET_FIELDCATALOG              (Optional) Sets Field Properties                            .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I SET_FILTER                    Sets Filter                                                 .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I SET_QUERYDATA                 Passes Data to Be Analyzed                                  .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I SET_TITLE                     Sets Description                                            .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY              I START_QUERY                   Starts BI Query                                             .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I COMMIT                        Confirms Data Without Starting Query                        .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I GET_URL                       Determines URL for Starting Query                           .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I SET_COMPONENTS_ALV            Passes Component Table of ALV                               .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I SET_QUERYDATA_ALVLIKE         Passes Data (In Internal ALV Format)                        .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I SET_QUERYPROPERTIES           Sets Query Properties                                       .
IF_RSROA_BI_QUERY_ADVANCED     I SET_TRANSIENT_SOURCE          Sets Transient Source                                       .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I GET_DTA                       Provides DTA Instance                                       .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I GET_GENUNIID                  Determines GENUNIID from COMPID                             .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I GET_INFOPROV_FROM_IOBJNM      Determines InfoProvider from InfoObject Name                .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I INSTANTIATE_QUERYDEF          Instantiates Query Definition                               .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I IS_INFOPROV_VIRTUAL           Checks Whether InfoProvider Has Virtual Metadata            .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I IS_IOBJ_VIRTUAL               Checks Whether InfoObject Has Virtual Metadata              .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I IS_QUERY_VIRTUAL              Checks Whether Query Is Executing on Virtual Metadata       .
IF_RSROA_VIRTUAL_QUERY         I READ_DATA                     Reads Transactional Data                                    .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I CREATE                        Create Instance with Input Parameters                       .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I DESCRIBE                      Return Description what the Atom Does                       .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I GET_PARAMETERS                Returns the Parameter Values Specified in Instance Creation .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I GET_PARAMETER_LIST            Returns the Parameters Needed for Creating an Instance      .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I REPAIR                        Analyze again and remove any errors                         .
IF_RSRV_ATOM                   I RUN                           Execute Atom                                                .
IF_RSRV_TEST                   I CREATE                        Create Instance                                             .
IF_RSRV_TEST                   I CREATE_ATOM_LIST              Build List with Instances of Atoms                          .
IF_RSRV_TEST                   I DESCRIBE                      Returns Description what the Test Does                      .
IF_RSRV_TEST                   I GET_PARAMETERS                Returns the Parameters Specified when Instance is Created   .
IF_RSRV_TEST                   I GET_PARAMETER_LIST            Returns the Parameters Needed for Creating an Instance      .
IF_RSR_BU_NODE                 I CREATE_MASK                   Initialize Template for Aggregation                         .
IF_RSR_BU_NODE                 I ELEMINATE                     Row Numbers to be Eliminated                                .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CHECK_FF_KEY_FF               Finds SP (Data) Using Selection (FF)                        .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CHECK_FF_KEY_FFID             Finds SP (Data) Using FFID                                  .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CLEAR_SPID                    Initializes SPID and Administration Object                  .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CLOSE                         Closes Cache (Clear)                                        .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I COMMIT                        Selects SP as Ready to be Saved                             .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CREATE_FF                     Generates New Selection (FF)                                .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I CREATE_SP                     Generates SP (Table)                                        .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I DELETE_FF                     Deletes Selection (FF) from Cache                           .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I FLUSH                         SPs with COMMIT are written to the persistence medium       .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I GET_FF_DIR                    Returns Directory of All Selections in Cache                .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I GET_GLOBAL_DATA               Returns Entry of Global Data                                .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I GET_SP_REF                    Returns SP to Selection (FF)                                .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I IS_GLOBAL_CACHE               It Concerns a Global Cache                                  .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I LOCK                          Locks Selection (FF)                                        .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I REFRESH                       Refreshes List of Selections (FF)                           .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I REPLACE_FF                    Replaces Selection (FF)                                     .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I SET_GLOBAL_DATA               Sets Entry 'Global Data'                                    .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I SET_RQTSS                     Sets Current Request of InfoProvider                        .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I SET_R_SP                      Sets SP (Data) Using Reference (Inclusive SPINFO)           .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I SET_SP                        Sets SP (Data) Directly                                     .
IF_RSR_CACHE_QUERY_CUBE        I UNLOCK                        Unlocks Selection (FF)                                      .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I AFTER_TRANSFORM               Clear                                                       .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I BEFORE_TRANSFORM              PREFETCH etc.                                               .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I FREE_DATA_REF                 Release Reference from GET_DATA_REF                         .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I GET_DATA_REF                  Get REF TO DATA for In-/Output Parameter                    .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I GET_FIELD_INFO_SHORT          Information for In-/Output Parameter                        .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I GET_MAPPING                   Generate Overlap Type                                       .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I GET_STRUCTURE_DESCR           Structure Description                                       .
IF_RSR_FIPT_TRANSFORMATOR      I TRANSFORM                     Ditto                                                       .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I DECLARATION_FINISHED          Declaration of Variables Complete                           .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I READ_GLOBV                    Reads a Globv                                               .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_PERIV                     You Can Set the Fiscal Year Variants Globally               .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_SX_VARIABLE               Returns the Finished SX_VARIABLE (to Persist)               .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_VARIABLE_FORMULA          Generates a Formula Variable                                .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_VARIABLE_HIERA            Generates a Hierarchy Variable                              .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_VARIABLE_NODE             Generates a Node Variable                                   .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_VARIABLE_TEXT             Generates a Text Variable                                   .
IF_RSR_LOCAL_VAR               I SET_VARIABLE_VALUE            Generates a Value Variable                                  .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_DT               I GET_CHANM                     Reference Characteristics                                   .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_DT               I GET_GLOBAL_VARIABLES          Parameters as Global Variables                              .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_DT               I GET_PROPERTIES                Key Figure Properties                                       .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_DT               I GET_VRNID                     VRNID If There Is a Variable Behind Replacement             .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_DT               I HAS_PROP                      Special Properties of the Replacement                       .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I GET_DATA_TIME_STAMP           Last Changed                                                .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I GET_VALUE                     Determine Value                                             .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I GET_VALUE_EXT                 Determine Value (More Than 4 Characteristics)               .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I NOTIFY_LIST                   Dynamic Filter, ...                                         .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I PREPARE                       Fill Buffer (1 Characteristic)                              .
IF_RSR_LOOKUP_RT               I START                         Set Variable Values                                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I BUFFER_RESET                  Deletes the data for the Delta_Buffer CGIDs                 .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CHECK_INPUTABLE               Check Ready for Input Status                                .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CHECK_NEW_LINES               Check Ready for Input Status of New Rows                    .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CLOSE_LIST                    Complete List (-" OLAP Cache)                               .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CREATE_NEW_ELTSID             Returns the Next Free ELTSIDs / KID                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CREATE_NEW_KID                Defines a Local Calculation Column                          .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I CREATE_PLAN_PROPOSAL          Generates Proposal from Planning Customizing                .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I DRILL_DOWN                    Expansion of  a (univ.) Hierarchy Node                      .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I EXECUTE_VQUERY                Notification of Characteristics and Filters for a List      .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I FREE                          Closing of a report                                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_AUTH                      Information on Authorization Check (RA)                     .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_CHAVL_NC_SIDS             Trigger SIDS for Non-compoundend Value (Exceptions)         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_DATA                      Get Report Data                                             .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_DATA_FLAT                 Fetch from Report Data in a E_T_DATA                        .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_DEFAULT_SETTINGS          Start List: Variable in Status (DYNCHANGE) and Conditions   .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_FIX_CHANMID               Supply Defined Characteristics (for Concatenation of chavl_ .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_HRY_INFO                  Returns Info on Active Hierarchies and Their Node Types     .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_INPUTABLE_DAT_N           Template for New Rows in Plan Query                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_RTO_DEFINITION            Provision of Technical Description for a Report             .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_RTO_TABLES                Returns Various Tables for a Runtime Object                 .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_SELDR                     Provides Current Restrictions                               .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_SRDATE                    Provides Key Date                                           .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_TOPICALITY_TIME           Returns the Currentness of the Data                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I GET_TXT_SYMBOLS               Build Text Symbols for Static Filters                       .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I HAS_PLAN_EMPTY                Query Supports Plan Empty                                   .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I MODIFY_CHANM_SETTINGS         Set Characteristic-specific Settings                        .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I MODIFY_QUERY_SETTINGS         Currency Conversion Etc.                                    .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I MODIFY_VQUERY_SETTINGS        Identifies Characteristic and Calls the Other MODIFY Methods.
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I NOTIFY_LIST                   Notification of Characteristics and Filters for a List      .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I OPEN_LIST                     Announce New List                                           .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I RELATIONAL_BROWSE             Relational browsing in characteristic values                .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SET_EXCEPTION_TLEVEL          Sets the Chanms for which an Exception with TLEVEL Cond.    .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SET_FLAGS                     Set Some Indicators                                         .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SET_INPUT                     Determine Input Readiness                                   .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SET_NEW_VALUES                Planning, Write New Key Figure Values                       .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SUPPORTS_F4_PLAN              Query Supports PlanProposal for Characteristic              .
IF_RSR_OLAP                    I SUPPORTS_F4_QUERY             Query Supports RelationalBrowse for Characteristic          .
IF_RSR_RRK0_AUTH_HIER          I CHECK_AUTH                    IF NOT c_sx_auth-auth IS INITIAL...                         .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I BROWSE                        BROWSE_NL (partially)                                       .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I CHECK_QCUBE                   QCUBE_BUFFER_READ                                           .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I CLEAR_QCUBE                   UNASSIGN_QCUBE                                              .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I COMPRESS_BUFFER_CGID          The Delta Buffer of a CGID Want to Compress                 .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I CREATE_CACHE                  CACHE_CREATE (partially)                                    .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I FLUSH_CACHE                   CACHE_FLUSH                                                 .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I FREE                          FREE_QCUBE                                                  .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I GET_ALL_FFIDS                 For OPTIMIZE_WGR                                            .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I GET_CS_APPEND                 Slow-Moving Items                                           .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I GET_DATA                      Returns an Instance with Data of an Aggregation Level       .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I IS_READ_ALL                   All modes simultaneously?                                   .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I NOTIFY_LIST                   RRK_LIST_NOTIFY (partially)                                 .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I REFRESH_CACHE                 CACHE_REFRESH                                               .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I REMOVE_HIERARCHY              HIERA_DELETE_BUF (partially)                                .
IF_RSR_RRK0_PARTITION          I RESET_CGID                    Discards the SPs of a CGID                                  .
IF_RSR_SETXX                   I INIT_CURSOR                   First Row fo the SETXX                                      .
IF_RSR_TRANSIENT_SOURCE        I CHECK_SELECTION               Überprüft die gültigkeit der Selektion                      .
IF_RSR_TRANSIENT_SOURCE        I GET_F4_VALUES                 Liefert F4 Werte und manipuliert vorhandene Werte           .
IF_RSR_TRANSIENT_SOURCE        I GET_SELECTION                 Liefert die Selektionsfelder zurück                         .
IF_RSR_TRANSIENT_SOURCE        I SUBMIT_SELECTION              Merkt sich die Selektion (beim Okay im Varbild)             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I FIND_VRNID                    Search for and Find Variable                                .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_CHANM                     Returns the Characteristic                                  .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_PERIV                     Fiscal Year Variant                                         .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_SELTYP                    Returns the Seltyp as Control for the GET_ for a VRNID      .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_SX_VARIABLE               Returns the Finished SX_VARIABLE (to Persist)               .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VAR01                     Returns the Main GLOBV Info for a VRNID                     .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_FORMULA_STRING      Get Method for a Formula Variable                           .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_FORMULA_VALUE       Get Method for a Formula Variable                           .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_HIERA               Get Method for a Hierarchy Variable                         .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_NODE                Get Method for a Node Variable                              .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_RANGESID            INTERN: Get Method Indpendent of Variable Type              .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_TEXT                Get Method for a Text Variable                              .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE               Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE_CHAVL         Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE_RANGE_CMP     Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE_RANGE_S       Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE_RANGE_T       Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_DEF                 I GET_VRNID_VALUE_SID           Get Method for a Value Varaible                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I ADD_BY_VAR_ID                 Add Variable for Browser-Back (screen change...)            .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I CHECK                         Check Values                                                .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I FREE                          Delete all                                                  .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_CURRENT_NVAR              Variable Values of Current Status                           .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_DEFINITION                Get Definition                                              .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_F4_PARAMETERS             Fixed Selection                                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_HELP_VALUES               F4 Help                                                     .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_INITIAL_STATE             Request Default Values                                      .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_INTERNAL_VALUES           Read Values in Internal Format (-"Variants, Personalization).
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_IOBJ_BLOCKED_STATE        InfoObjects with Incompatible Filter Status                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_RUNTIME_INFO              Info for Atomic Runtime Objects in the Container            .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_VALUES                    Read values                                                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I GET_VAR_TXT_SYMBOLS           Text symbols                                                .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I NODE_GET_CHILDREN             Get Lower-level Hierarchy Nodes                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I READ_PERS_VALUES              Reset Values for a Variable to Personalized Values          .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I READ_VARIANT                  Get variant                                                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I RESET_IOBJ_STATE              Reset Filter Status of an InfoObject                        .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I RESOLVE                       INTERNAL!!! References to CL_RSR_VAR                        .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SAVE_PERS_VALUES              Store Values for a Variable in Personalization              .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SAVE_VARIANT                  Save Variant                                                .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SCREEN_NECESSARY              Variable Screen Absolutely Necessary                        .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SCREEN_POSSIBLE               Variables Screen Possible                                   .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SEND_ABAP_DYNPRO              Display SAP GUI Variable Screen                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SET_HIERARCHY                 Set Hierarchy for Node Variables                            .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SET_INITIAL_STATE             Set Initial Status                                          .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SET_INTERNAL_VALUES           Set Values in Internal Format (BRUTE FORCE!!!)              .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SET_VALUES                    Set values                                                  .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME             I SUBMIT                        Send Values                                                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I DELETE_VARIANT                Delete Variant                                              .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I GET_HELP_VALUES               F4 Help                                                     .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I GET_VARIANT_LIST              Variants F4                                                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I NODE_GET_CHILDREN             Get Lower-level Hierarchy Nodes                             .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I NODE_GET_SEARCH_TREE          Search Tree for Node                                        .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I READ_PERS_VALUES              Reset Values for a Variable to Personalized Values          .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I READ_VARIANT                  Get variant                                                 .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I SAVE_PERS_VALUES              Store Values for a Variable in Personalization              .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I SAVE_VARIANT                  Save Variant                                                .
IF_RSR_VAR_RUNTIME_OBSOLETE    I SUPPORTS_VARIANTS             Variants Can Be Read and Saved                              .
IF_RSR_WWW_HELP_WINDOW_FORMULA I GET_ALLOWED_OPERATORS         Deliver Available Operators                                 .
IF_RSR_WWW_HELP_WINDOW_FORMULA I GET_FORMULA                   Get Existing Formula Definition                             .
IF_RSR_WWW_HELP_WINDOW_FORMULA I GET_FORMULA_ELEMENTS          Get Formula Components                                      .
IF_RSR_WWW_HELP_WINDOW_FORMULA I SET_NEW_FORMULA               Submit Formula                                              .
IF_RSR_WWW_VALUE_PROVIDER      I GET_ACTION                    Gets Value Provider Action After Fire Back                  .
IF_RSR_WWW_VALUE_PROVIDER      I GET_ATR                       Retrieve Selectable Attribute                               .
IF_RSR_WWW_VALUE_PROVIDER      I GET_VALUES                    Retrieves Values Sufficient For Select Options              .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I CHANGE_AUTHTYPE               Change Authorization Type                                   .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I CHANGE_COMPMODE               Validity Range of Authorization                             .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I CHANGE_TLEVEL                 Authorization to X Level                                    .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I CHANGE_VARDEFAULT             This Authorization / Node is the Default for Node Variables .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I DELETE                        Delete object                                               .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I DELETE_BY_IOBJNM              Delete Value for an InfoObject                              .
IF_RSSBR_OBJECT_MODIFY         I INSERT_VALUE                  Insert values                                               .
IF_RSSEM_INFOPROV_READ         I READ_WITH_SIDMAP              Read with SID Conversion                                    .
IF_RSSEM_SIDMAP                I GET_CONVERSION_REFERENCE      Determine Assignment Table                                  .
IF_RSSH_HIERMAINTAIN           I CHANGE_EVENTS                 Tree Events to be Triggered                                 .
IF_RSSH_HIERMAINTAIN           I GET_NODEFLAVOR                Gets Drag&Drop Flavor (Optional)                            .
IF_RSSM_RDA_DATAPACK_OBSERVER  I DEQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Release Status Tables                                       .
IF_RSSM_RDA_DATAPACK_OBSERVER  I ENQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Lock Status Tables                                          .
IF_RSSM_RDA_DATAPACK_OBSERVER  I UPDATE_STATUS_TABLES          Refresh Status Tables                                       .
IF_RSSM_RDA_REQUEST_OBSERVER   I AFTER_FINAL_STATE_TRANSITION  Final Status                                                .
IF_RSSM_RDA_REQUEST_OBSERVER   I DEQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Release Status Tables                                       .
IF_RSSM_RDA_REQUEST_OBSERVER   I ENQUEUE_STATUS_TABLES         Lock Status Tables                                          .
IF_RSSM_RDA_REQUEST_OBSERVER   I UPDATE_STATUS_TABLES          Refresh Status Tables                                       .
IF_RSSO_SELECTION              I GET_CHARACTERISTIC_LIST       Procure Characteristic List                                 .
IF_RSSTATMAN                   I GET_STATUS                    Returns the Status of the Action                            .
IF_RSTRAN_FOBU_CONNECT         I IS_CHANGED                    Returns change indicator and initializes after query        .
IF_RSTRAN_FOBU_CONNECT         I SET_FIELDS                    Transfer Application Fields to Connector                    .
IF_RSTRAN_RUNTIME              I EXECUTE                       Execute Transformation                                      .
IF_RSTRAN_SOURCE               I CONVERT_REAL_OBJECTS          Return Corrected Source Names                               .
IF_RSTRAN_SOURCE               I GET_HEADER                    Returns Header Information                                  .
IF_RSTRAN_SOURCE               I GET_LIST                      Deliver List of Fields or InfoObjects                       .
IF_RSTRAN_SOURCE               I GET_OBJ_REF                   Deliver Reference to Source Object                          .
IF_RSTRAN_SOURCE               I GET_VALUE_HELP                Return Single Object (F4 Search)                            .
IF_RSTRAN_TARGET               I GET_HEADER                    Returns Header Information                                  .
IF_RSTRAN_TARGET               I GET_LIST                      Deliver List of Fields or InfoObjects                       .
IF_RSTRAN_TARGET               I GET_OBJ_REF                   Deliver Reference to Target Object                          .
IF_RSTRAN_TARGET               I GET_VALUE_HELP                Return Single Object (F4 Search)                            .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS                 I GET_STRUC_N                   Get ref to structure containing system indep. format        .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS                 I TRANSFORM                     Transform structure back to system dependent format         .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS                 I TRANSFORM_N                   Transform SIDs in structure to system-independent format    .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS                 I UPDATE_STRUCTURE              Update structure content to newest possible values          .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS_TC              I GET_TC_LIST                   Get list of all available Testcases                         .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS_TC              I TRANSFORM                     Transform to system dep format and store testcase           .
IF_RSTTU_TRANS_TC              I TRANSFORM_N                   Transform SIDs in structure to system-independent format    .
IF_RSTT_PLAYVAR_BUFFER         I RESTORE_STATUS                Restore the Current Status of PLAYVAR Attributes            .
IF_RSTT_PLAYVAR_BUFFER         I SAVE_STATUS                   Saves Current Status of PLAYVAR Attributes                  .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I CHECK_PLAYMODE_EXIST          Checks Whether Processing Modes Exist                       .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_AUTOTEST_TYPES            Get Types for Automatic Tests/Tools                         .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_CATT_FUNCS                Get Test Functions for a Topic                              .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_CATT_REFTP                Get Test Reference Types                                    .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_CATT_TOPICS               Get Test Topics and Functions                               .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_CATT_TTYPE                Get Trace Types for CATT Trace                              .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_DISPMODE                  Get Display Modes                                           .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_ERROR_AREA                Determine Error Areas                                       .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_JOB_LOGMODES              Get Log Mods for Jobs                                       .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_JOB_PARALLEL_MODES        Get Parallelization Modes                                   .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_JOB_PERIODMODES           Get Period Modes for Job Scheduling                         .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_JOB_PROCESSMODES          Get Process Modes for Jobs                                  .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_PLAYMODES                 Get Processing Variants                                     .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_TLAYER                    Get Application Layers                                      .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_TOBJTYPE                  Get Test Object Types                                       .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I GET_TOBJ_DESCR                Determine Description for Test Objects                      .
IF_RSTT_TAREA                  I HAS_TOOL_PROCESSING           Intended for Trace and CATT processing?                     .
IF_RSTT_TDATA                  I FREE_TUNIT_DATA               Release Data for Current Test Unit                          .
IF_RSTT_TDATA                  I GET_SUB_TDATATP               Get Subtypes of Test Data                                   .
IF_RSTT_TDATA                  I GET_TUNIT_DATA                Get Data for Current Test Unit                              .
IF_RSTT_TDATA                  I LOAD                          Load Test Data for Object                                   .
IF_RSTT_TDATA                  I STORE                         Store Object Test Data                                      .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_ATTRIBUTS      Generate Output List for Corresponding Attributes           .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_LINK           Generate Output List for Links                              .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_PARAM          Generate Output List for Specific Parameter                 .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_TESTS          Generate Output List for Other Tests                        .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_TOBJLIST       Generate Output List for Corresponding Test Object Templates.
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_DISPLAY_TRACELIST      Generate Output List for Corresponding Traces               .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I CREATE_NEW                    Generate Instance for New Test Request                      .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I DELETE_TREQ                   Delete Test Request                                         .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I EDIT_LINK_ENTRY               Edit Entry for Corresponding Links                          .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I EDIT_PARAM_ENTRY              Edit Entry for Corresponding Parameters                     .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I EDIT_TEST_ENTRY               Edit Entry for Test Case                                    .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I EDIT_TOBJ_ENTRY               Edit Entry for Corresponding Test Object Templates          .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I LOAD_TREQ                     Generate Instance for Existing Test Request                 .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I SAVE_TREQ                     Save Instance                                               .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I SELECT_TREQ                   Determine Selection from Test Requests                      .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I SET_ATTRIBUTS                 Transfer Attributes to Instance                             .
IF_RSTT_TREQ                   I UPDATE_TRACE_STATUS           Determine Status for Trace Assignment                       .
IF_RSTT_TSCEN                  I CREATE                        Create Instance                                             .
IF_RSTT_TSCEN                  I DESERIALIZE                   Deserialize (Import) Test Scenario                          .
IF_RSTT_TSCEN                  I EXPORT                        Export Test Scenario                                        .
IF_RSTT_TSCEN                  I IMPORT                        Import Test Scenario                                        .
IF_RSTT_TSCEN                  I SERIALIZE                     Serialize (Export) Test Scenario                            .
IF_RSTT_UI_POS_FOR_DETAILS     I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_RSTT_UI_POS_FOR_DETAILS     I GET_DESCRIBING_ID             Returns the ID for This Selection                           .
IF_RSTT_UI_POS_FOR_DETAILS     I GET_LINES_OF_TABLE            Returns the Rows of the Position Table                      .
IF_RSTT_UI_POS_FOR_DETAILS     I GET_POS                       Sets the Current Check or Reference Data Position           .
IF_RSTT_UI_POS_FOR_DETAILS     I SET_POS                       Returns the Current Check or Reference Data Position        .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I CREATE_CONTEXT                Generate Context                                            .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I CREATE_UI                     Generate UI Element                                         .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I FILL_DATA                     Transfer Data to Instance                                   .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_DATA                      Requests Data from Instance                                 .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_EVENT_COMP_INDEX          Requests Component Index of Event                           .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_MULTISEL                  Get Existing Instance                                       .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_RANGE_DATA                Return Range Table                                          .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_WINDOW_OPTION             Get Options Window                                          .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I GET_WINDOW_RANGE              Get Range Window                                            .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I HAS_CHANGED                   Was range structure changed?                                .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I SET_OPTION_DATA               Transfer Options Parameter to Instance                      .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I SET_RANGE_DATA                Transfer Range Table to Instance                            .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I UPDATE_COMP_FROM_INPUT        Refresh Component Using Input Values                        .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I UPDATE_COMP_FROM_INPUT_ALL    Check All Input Fields and Refresh Range If Necessary       .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I UPDATE_COMP_FROM_OPTION       Refresh Component Using Option Values                       .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I UPDATE_COMP_FROM_RANGE        Refresh Component Using Range Table                         .
IF_RSTT_WDY_MULTISEL           I UPDATE_CONTEXT_ALL            Fill All Context Nodes Based on Current Range Structure     .
IF_RSZA_CALLBACK_LIST_RENDERER I GET_LIST_RENDERING_ITEM       Creates HTML Code for List Items                            .
IF_RSZA_CALLBACK_TABS_RENDERER I GET_URL_TABSTRIP              Creates HTML Code for List Items                            .
IF_RSZA_CALLBACK_TREE_RENDERER I GET_TREE_RENDERING_NODE_TEXT  Creates HTML for Output of Entry in Tree                    .
IF_RSZA_CALLBACK_TREE_RENDERER I GET_TREE_RENDERING_TOGGLE_URL Delivers URL for Opening/Closing the Branch Node ID         .
IF_RS_BBS_BADI_HANDLER         I CALL_BATCH                    Call as Subsequent Action in RA (Batch)                     .
IF_RS_BBS_BADI_HANDLER         I CALL_SAPGUI                   Call in SAP GUI                                             .
IF_RS_BBS_BADI_HANDLER         I CALL_URL                      Call in Web                                                 .
IF_RS_BBS_BADI_HANDLER         I GET_TARGETS                   List of Available Jump Targets for a Type                   .
IF_RS_SOBI_DT_UI               I CREATE                        Dialog Build                                                .
IF_RS_SOBI_DT_UI               I GET_LAUNCHER                  Returns Instance of Launcher                                .
IF_RS_SOBI_DT_UI               I GET_TITLE                     Returns Title for Dialog                                    .
IF_RS_SOBI_DT_UI_COMMAND       I GET_ACTIVE_TABSTRIP           Returns Associated Tab Page                                 .
IF_RS_SOBI_DT_UI_COMMAND       I GET_OBJECT                    Returns Objects Used                                        .
IF_RTTBF_TRAN_CONTXT_TRANSMTTR I GET_LOCKGUID_FOR_RECORD       Create Lock Reference with Parent-Child Relationship        .
IF_RTTBF_TRAN_CONTXT_TRANSMTTR I SINGLE_PREPARE_SAVE_FOR_RELTN Prepare Child Aspects for SAVE                              .
IF_RTTBF_TRAN_CONTXT_TRANSMTTR I SINGLE_REFRESH_BUFF_FOR_RELTN Prepare Child Aspects for SAVE                              .
IF_RTTBF_TRAN_HANDLER          I GET_RTTBF_TRAN_TABL_BUFFER    Factory Method for Table Buffer                             .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I CLEAR_ACTIVE                  Set Rule Component to Inactive                              .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I CLEAR_ASSIGNED                Set Rule Component to Not Assigned                          .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I GET_ACTIVE                    Rule Component Active/Inactive?                             .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I GET_ASSIGNED                  Rule Component (Not) Assigned?                              .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I PROCESS                       Executes Rule Component                                     .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I SET_ACTIVE                    Set Rule Component to Active                                .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I SET_APPLCLASS                 Sets Application Class                                      .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I SET_ASSIGNED                  Set Rule Component to Assigned                              .
IF_RULE_COMPONENT_BRF          I STORE_RESULTS                 Saves Boolean Result Subtree                                .
IF_RULE_MM                     I ASSIGN_DEPENDENCIES           Setup Rule Base                                             .
IF_RULE_MM                     I ATTACH                        Attach an Observer/Dependent Rule                           .
IF_RULE_MM                     I BREAK                         Break This Rule/Dependants Will Also Break                  .
IF_RULE_MM                     I EXECUTE                       Execute the Check - Will Break or Update or Nop             .
IF_RULE_MM                     I GET_NO_OF_DEPENDANTS          How Many Dependent Rules Exist (Deep)?                      .
IF_RULE_MM                     I GET_NO_OF_PRECOND             How Many Preconditions Exist (Shallow)?                     .
IF_RULE_MM                     I UPDATE                        Rule Still Holds But Value Updated/Dependants Will Have To  .
IF_RWB_RUNTIME_CHECK           I GET_SETTINGS                  Transfers Table of Relevant Settings                        .
IF_RWB_RUNTIME_CHECK           I GET_SETTINGS_BY_CATEGORY      Tranfers Table of Settings for Particular Category          .
IF_RWB_RUNTIME_CHECK           I GET_SETTING_CATEGORIES        Transfers Categories of Settings                            .
IF_RWB_RUNTIME_CHECK           I PING                          Ping Query                                                  .
IF_RWB_RUNTIME_CHECK           I SELFTEST                      Consistency checks                                          .
IF_S95_MAINTENANCE_REQUEST     I RECEIVE_MAINTENANCE_REQUEST   Receive MaintenanceRequest message from the MES System      .
IF_S95_MAINTENANCE_RESPONSE    I SEND_MAINTENANCE_RESPONSE     Sends the MaintenanceResponse message to the MES System     .
IF_S95_MAINTENANCE_WORK_ORDER  I SEND_MAINTENANCE_WORK_ORDER   Sends the MaintenanceWorkOrder message to the MES System    .
IF_S95_MESSAGE_LOG_HANDLER     I ADD_MESSAGE_TO_LOG            Add message to log                                          .
IF_S95_MESSAGE_LOG_HANDLER     I SAVE_LOG                      Save Application Log                                        .
IF_S95_PRODUCTION_PERFORMANCE  I RECEIVE_PRODUCTION_PERFORMANCEReceive ProductionPerformance message from the MES System   .
IF_S95_PRODUCTION_SCHEDULE     I SEND_PRODUCTION_SCHEDULE      Send ProductionSchedule message to Shop Floor system        .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER                I COMPLETE_METADATA             Completing Meta Data                                        .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER                I GET_METADATA                  Metadata is read by underlying tool                         .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER                I SET_METADATA                  Metadata will be set in underlying tool                     .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I GET_CURRENT_CELL              Get Current Footer Cell                                     .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I GET_SELECTED_CELLS            Get Selected Cells                                          .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I GET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Get Selected Columns                                        .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Get Selected Rows                                           .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I SET_CURRENT_CELL              Set Focus Cell                                              .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I SET_SELECTED_CELLS            Set Selected Cells                                          .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I SET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Set Selected Columns                                        .
IF_SALV_ADAPTER_SELECTIONS     I SET_SELECTED_ROWS             Set Selected Rows                                           .
IF_SALV_BS_TT_UTIL             I TRANSFORM                     Transforms According to Defined XML Version                 .
IF_SALV_DISPLAY_ADAPTER        I GET_CALLBACK_PROGRAM          Get Name of the Calling Program                             .
IF_SALV_DISPLAY_ADAPTER        I GET_COLUMNS                   Get Columns                                                 .
IF_SALV_DISPLAY_ADAPTER        I GET_SELECTION_MODE            Get Selection Mode                                          .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_ADDED_FUNCTION          Event for Application-Specific Functions                    .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_AFTER_SALV_FUNCTION     Event After ALV Functions                                   .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_BEFORE_SALV_FUNCTION    Event Before ALV Functions                                  .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_BUILD_UIFUNCTION        Event for Building Application Toolbar                      .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_DOUBLE_CLICK            Event for Double-Click                                      .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_END_OF_LIST             Event for Processing the List End                           .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_END_OF_LIST_PRINT       Event for Processing the List End in Printing               .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_END_OF_PAGE             Event for Processing the Page End                           .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_HOTSPOT_CLICK           Event for Hotspot-Click                                     .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_TOP_OF_LIST             Event for Processing the List Start                         .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_TOP_OF_LIST_PRINT       Event for Processing the List Start in Printing             .
IF_SALV_EVENTS_ADAPTER         I RAISE_TOP_OF_PAGE             Event for Processing the Page Start                         .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Footer Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_SUMS            Shows Whether Subtotals Will Be Exported                    .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Header Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Export -" Excel: Excludes Design Obj. of Footer Area        .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_SUMS            Export -" Excel: Excludes Totlas and Subtotals              .
IF_SALV_EX_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Export -" Excel: Excludes Design Obj. of Header Area        .
IF_SALV_FORM_ABSTRACT          I DISPLAY                       Display Information                                         .
IF_SALV_STATUS_ADAPTER         I BUILD_UIFUNCTION              Building Application Toolbar                                .
IF_SALV_TOOLBAR_ADAPTER        I BUILD_UIFUNCTION              Building Application Toolbar                                .
IF_SALV_TREE_ADAPTER           I GET_ALV_TREE                  Get Instance of CL_GUI_ALV_TREE                             .
IF_SALV_WD_AGGR                I CREATE_AGGR_RULE              Generates the Aggregation Condition for the Field           .
IF_SALV_WD_AGGR                I DELETE_AGGR_RULE              Deletes an Aggregation Condition for the Object             .
IF_SALV_WD_AGGR                I GET_AGGR_RULE                 Returns an Aggregation Condition for the Field              .
IF_SALV_WD_AGGR                I IS_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED        Displays Whether Aggregation is Permitted for the Field     .
IF_SALV_WD_AGGR                I SET_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED       Sets Whether Field Can Be Aggregated                        .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_HIERARCHY    I IS_HIERARCHY_COLUMN           Returns Whether Column Is Hierarchy Column                  .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_HIERARCHY    I SET_HIERARCHY_COLUMN          Sets the Column as Hierarchy Column                         .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_REF          I GET_TEXT_FIELDNAME            Returns the Field the Values of Which Are Displayed in Col. .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_REF          I SET_TEXT_FIELDNAME            Sets Field the Values of Which Are Displayed in the Column  .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SERVICE_REF  I GET_FILTER_FIELDNAME          Returns Field the Values of Which Are Used to Filter Column .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SERVICE_REF  I GET_SORT_FIELDNAME            Returns Field the Values of Which Are Used to Sort Column   .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SERVICE_REF  I SET_FILTER_FIELDNAME          Sets Field Whose Values Are Used to Sort Column             .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SERVICE_REF  I SET_SORT_FIELDNAME            Sets Field Whose Values Are Used to Sort the Column         .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SETTINGS     I CREATE_COLUMN                 Generates the Object of a Column                            .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SETTINGS     I DELETE_COLUMN                 Deletes the Object of a Column                              .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SETTINGS     I GET_COLUMN                    Returns the Object of a Column                              .
IF_SALV_WD_COLUMN_SETTINGS     I GET_COLUMNS                   Returns the Objects of All Columns                          .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Footer Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_SUMS            Shows Whether Subtotals Will Be Exported                    .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I GET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Header Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Export -" Excel: Excludes Design Obj. of Footer Area        .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_SUMS            Export -" Excel: Excludes Totlas and Subtotals              .
IF_SALV_WD_EXPORT_SETTINGS     I SET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Export -" Excel: Excludes Design Obj. of Header Area        .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I CREATE_FIELD                  Generates the Object of a Field in the Internal Data Table  .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I DELETE_FIELD                  Deletes the Object of a Field in the Internal Data Table    .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_AGGR_BEFORE_ITEMS         Shows Where the Results Row of the Aggregation Is Located   .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_EXPAND_LEVEL              Returns the Level During Drilldown of Subtotals             .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_FIELD                     Returns the Object of a Field                               .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_FIELDS                    Returns the Objects of All Fields                           .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_GROUP_AGGR_COLLAPSED      Indicates Whether Interim Results Are Aggregated            .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I GET_GROUP_AGGR_DISPLAYED      Checks Whether Interim Results Are Displayed                .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I IS_COUNT_RECORDS_ENABLED      Shows Whether Number of Data Records Is Displayed           .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I SET_AGGR_BEFORE_ITEMS         Places the Results Row Above the Data Records               .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I SET_COUNT_RECORDS_ENABLED     Counts Data Records and Displays Result                     .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I SET_EXPAND_LEVEL              Sets the Level at Drilldown of Subtotals                    .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I SET_GROUP_AGGR_COLLAPSED      Aggregates Interim Results to Highest Level                 .
IF_SALV_WD_FIELD_SETTINGS      I SET_GROUP_AGGR_DISPLAYED      Displays Interim Results                                    .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I CREATE_FILTER_RULE            Generates a Filter Condition for the Field                  .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I DELETE_FILTER_RULE            Deletes a Filter Condition for the Field                    .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I DELETE_FILTER_RULES           Deletes All Filter Conditions for the Field                 .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I GET_FILTER_RULE               Returns a Specific Filter Condition for the Field           .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I GET_FILTER_RULES              Returns All Filter Conditions for the Field                 .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I IS_FILTER_ALLOWED             Shows Whether Values Can be Filtered by Values of the Field .
IF_SALV_WD_FILTER              I SET_FILTER_ALLOWED            Permits Filtering by values for the Field                   .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I CREATE_FUNCTION               Generates an Object for a User-Defined Function (Left)      .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I CREATE_FUNCTION_RIGHT         Generates an Object for a User-Defined Function (Right)     .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I DELETE_FUNCTION               Deletes a User-Defined Function (Left)                      .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I DELETE_FUNCTION_RIGHT         Deletes a User-Defined Function (Right)                     .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_ENABLED                   Shows Whether the Toolbar Is Active                         .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_FUNCTION                  Returns an Object for a User-Defined Function (Left)        .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_FUNCTIONS                 Returns All Objects for User-Defined Functions (Left)       .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_FUNCTIONS_RIGHT           Returns All Objects for User-Defined Functions (Right)      .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_FUNCTION_RIGHT            Returns an Objects of a User-Defined Function (Right)       .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I GET_VISIBLE                   Shows Whether the Functions in the Toolbar Are Visible      .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I SET_ENABLED                   Activates All Functions of the Toolbar                      .
IF_SALV_WD_FUNCTION_SETTINGS   I SET_VISIBLE                   Shows Functions in the Toolbar                              .
IF_SALV_WD_KAYAK               I GET_PDF_XML                   Returns XML for PDF Generation                              .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Footer Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Shows Whether Design Obj. for Header Area Will Be Exported  .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_CENTER             Returns Centered Text Module of Footer                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_CENTER_FREETEXT    Returns Centered Free Text of Footer                        .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_LEFT               Returns Left Text Module of Footer                          .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_LEFT_FREETEXT      Returns Left Free Text of Footer                            .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_RIGHT              Returns Right Text Module of Footer                         .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_FOOTER_RIGHT_FREETEXT     Returns Right Free Text of Footer                           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_CENTER             Returns Centered Text Module of Header                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_CENTER_FREETEXT    Returns Centered Free Text of Header                        .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_LEFT               Returns Left Text Module of Header                          .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_LEFT_FREETEXT      Returns Left Free Text of Header                            .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_RIGHT              Returns Right Text Module of Header                         .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_HEADER_RIGHT_FREETEXT     Returns Right Free Text of Header                           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_MARGINS_UNIT              Returns Unit of Measure for the Margins                     .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_MARGIN_BOTTOM             Returns Width of Bottom Margin                              .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_MARGIN_LEFT               Returns Width of Left Margin                                .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_MARGIN_RIGHT              Returns Width of Right Margin                               .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_MARGIN_TOP                Returns Width of Top Margin                                 .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_ORIENTATION               Returns Orientation of Page as Portrait or Landscape Format .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_PAGE_LAYOUT               Returns Scaling of ALV Output on Page                       .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_PAGE_SIZE                 Returns Paper Size of Page                                  .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_PRINTER                   Returns Output Printer                                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_PRINT_IMMEDIATE           Returns Flag for Immediate Output to Printer                .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_REPEAT_HEADERS_FIT_H      Shows Repeat of Column Heading for Modified Page Width      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_REPEAT_HEADERS_WALLPAPER  Shows Repeat of Column Heading for Adjacent Pages           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I GET_REPEAT_KEY_COLUMNS        Shows Repeat of Non-Scrollable Columns                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_EXPORT_NO_EOL             Export Excludes Design Object of Footer Area                .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_EXPORT_NO_TOL             Export Excludes Design Object of Header Area                .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_CENTER             Defines Centered Text Module of Footer                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_CENTER_FREETEXT    Defines Centered Free Text of Footer                        .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_LEFT               Defines Left Text Module of Footer                          .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_LEFT_FREETEXT      Defines Left Free Text of Footer                            .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_RIGHT              Defines Right Text Module of Footer                         .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_FOOTER_RIGHT_FREETEXT     Defines Right Free Text of Footer                           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_CENTER             Defines Centered Text Module of Header                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_CENTER_FREETEXT    Defines Centered Free Text of Header                        .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_LEFT               Defines Left Text Module of Header                          .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_LEFT_FREETEXT      Defines Left Free Text of Header                            .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_RIGHT              Defines Right Text Module of Header                         .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_HEADER_RIGHT_FREETEXT     Defines Right Free Text of Header                           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_MARGINS_UNIT              Sets Unit of Measure for Margins                            .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_MARGIN_BOTTOM             Sets Width of Bottom Margin                                 .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_MARGIN_LEFT               Sets Width of Left Margin                                   .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_MARGIN_RIGHT              Sets Width of Right Margin                                  .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_MARGIN_TOP                Sets Width of Top Margin                                    .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_ORIENTATION               Sets Whether Page Is Portrait of Landscape Format           .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_PAGE_LAYOUT               Sets Scaling of ALV Output on Page                          .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_PAGE_SIZE                 Sets Paper Size of Page                                     .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_PRINTER                   Defines Output Printer                                      .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_PRINT_IMMEDIATE           Sets Flag for Immediate Output to Printer                   .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_REPEAT_HEADERS_FIT_H      Repeats Column Heading for Modified Page Width              .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_REPEAT_HEADERS_WALLPAPER  Repeats Column Heading for Adjacent Pages                   .
IF_SALV_WD_PDF_SETTINGS        I SET_REPEAT_KEY_COLUMNS        Repeats Non-Scrollable Columns on Each Page                 .
IF_SALV_WD_SERVICES            I GET_PDF_XML                   Returns XML for PDF Generation                              .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I CREATE_SORT_RULE              Generates the Sort Condition for the Field                  .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I DELETE_SORT_RULE              Deletes the Sort Condition for the Field                    .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I GET_SORT_RULE                 Returns the Sort Condition for the Field                    .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I IS_GROUPING_ALLOWED           Shows Whether Same Values in Field Are Combined             .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I IS_GROUP_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED  Shows Whether Intermediate Results Are Permitted for Field  .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I IS_SORT_ALLOWED               Shows Whether Field Can Be Used for Sorting                 .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I SET_GROUPING_ALLOWED          Combines Same Values in Sorted Field into One               .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I SET_GROUP_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED Permits Formation of Intermediate Results Using This Field  .
IF_SALV_WD_SORT                I SET_SORT_ALLOWED              Permits Sorting By This Field                               .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED        Shows Whether the Tab Page "Calculation" Is Visible         .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_COLUMN_SELECTION_ALLOWED   Shows Whether Tab Page "Column Selection" Is Visible        .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_COUNT_RECORDS_ALLOWED      Shows Whether Checkbox "Count Table Entries" Is Visible     .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_DIALOG_SETTINGS_ALLOWED    Shows Whether Pushbutton "Settings" is Visible              .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_DISPLAY_SETTINGS_ALLOWED   Shows Whether Tab Page "Display" Is Visible                 .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_APPEND_ROWS_ALLOWED   Method is obsolete                                          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_APPEND_ROW_ALLOWED    Shows Whether Pushbutton "Attach Row" Is Visible            .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_CHECK_AVAILABLE       Shows Whether Pushbutton "Check" Is Visible                 .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_DELETE_ROW_ALLOWED    Shows Whether Pushbutton "Delete Row" Is Visible            .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_INSERT_ROWS_ALLOWED   Method is obsolete                                          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_INSERT_ROW_ALLOWED    Shows Whether Pushbutton "Insert Rows" Is Visible           .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EDIT_UNDO_ALLOWED          Shows Whether Pushbutton "Undo" Is Visible                  .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_EXPORT_ALLOWED             Shows Whether Pushbutton "Excel" Is Visible                 .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_FILTER_COMPLEX_ALLOWED     Shows Whether Tab Page "Filter" Is Visible                  .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_FILTER_FILTERLINE_ALLOWED  Shows Whether Pushbutton "Filter" Is Visible                .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_GROUP_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED  Shows Whether Interface Elements for Subtotals Are Visible  .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_PDF_ALLOWED                Shows Whether Pushbutton/Tab Page "PDF" is Visible          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_SORT_COMPLEX_ALLOWED       Shows Whether Tab Page "Sorting" Is Visible                 .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_SORT_HEADERCLICK_ALLOWED   Shows Whether Sort Occurs with Single Click on Col. Heading .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I IS_VIEW_LIST_ALLOWED          Shows Whether Dropdown List Box for Views Is Displayed      .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED       Shows/Hides "Calculation" Tab Page                          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_COLUMN_SELECTION_ALLOWED  Shows/Hides "Column Selection" Tab Page                     .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_COUNT_RECORDS_ALLOWED     Shows/Hides "Count Table Entries" Checkbox                  .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_DIALOG_SETTINGS_ALLOWED   Shows or Hides Pushbutton "Settings"                        .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_DISPLAY_SETTINGS_ALLOWED  Shows/Hides "Display" Tab Page                              .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_APPEND_ROWS_ALLOWED  Method is obsolete                                          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_APPEND_ROW_ALLOWED   Shows/Hides "Attach Rows" Pushbutton                        .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_CHECK_AVAILABLE      Shows/Hides "Check" Pushbutton                              .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_DELETE_ROW_ALLOWED   Shows/Hides "Delete Row" Pushbutton                         .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_INSERT_ROWS_ALLOWED  Method is obsolete                                          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_INSERT_ROW_ALLOWED   Shows/Hides "Insert Row" Pushbutton                         .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EDIT_UNDO_ALLOWED         Shows/Hides "Undo" Pushbutton                               .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_EXPORT_ALLOWED            Shows/Hides "Excel" Pushbutton                              .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_FILTER_COMPLEX_ALLOWED    Shows/Hides "Filter" Tab Page                               .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_FILTER_FILTERLINE_ALLOWED Shows/Hides "Filter" Pushbutton                             .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_GROUP_AGGREGATION_ALLOWED Shows/Hides UI Elements for Intermediate Result             .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_PDF_ALLOWED               Shows/Hides Pushbutton / Tab Page "PDF"                     .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_SORT_COMPLEX_ALLOWED      Shows/Hides "Sorting" Tab Page                              .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_SORT_HEADERCLICK_ALLOWED  Enables Sorting with Simple Click on Column Header          .
IF_SALV_WD_STD_FUNCTIONS       I SET_VIEW_LIST_ALLOWED         Shows/Hides Dropdown List Box for Saved Views               .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I CREATE_HEADER                 Generates an Object for the Table Header                    .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I DELETE_HEADER                 Deletes the Object for the Table Header                     .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_DATA_CHECK                Returns When the Change of Data Will Be Checked             .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_DESIGN                    Returns the Design of the ALV Output                        .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_DISPLAY_TYPE              Returns the Type of Display, for example Table, Hierarchy   .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_EDIT_MODE                 Indicates Whether the Mode for Mass Data Has Been Actiavted .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_EMPTY_TABLE_TEXT          Returns the Replacement Text with an Empty ALV Output       .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_ENABLED                   Returns Whether Functional Areas Are Active                 .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_END_OF_LIST_VISIBLE       Shows Whether Design Object for the Footer Is Displayed     .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW         Returns the First Visible Row                               .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_FIRST_VISIBLE_SCROLL_COL  Returns First Scrollable Column                             .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_FIXED_TABLE_LAYOUT        Shows Whether Width of ALV Output Is Independent of Content .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_FOOTER_VISIBLE            Shows Whether the Footer with Pagination Is Displayed       .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_GRID_MODE                 Shows Whether Grid Lines Are Shown                          .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_HEADER                    Returns the Object of the Table Header                      .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_READ_ONLY                 Shows Whether the ALV Output Is Write Protected             .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_ROW_SELECTABLE            Indicates Whether the Rows of the ALV Output Can Be Selected.
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_ROW_SELECTABLE_FIELDNAME  Returns Field for Selectability of Individual Rows          .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_SCROLLABLE_COL_COUNT      Returns Number of Scrollable Columns That Can Be Displayed  .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_SELECTION_MODE            Returns the Marking Type                                    .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_TOOLTIP                   Returns the Tooltip for the Entire ALV Output               .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_TOP_OF_LIST_VISIBLE       Shows Whether Design Object of Header Area Is Displayed     .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_VISIBLE                   Shows Whether Table Is Visible                              .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_VISIBLE_ROW_COUNT         Returns the Height of the ALV Output in Rows                .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I GET_WIDTH                     Returns the Width of the ALV Output                         .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_DATA_CHECK                Sets When the Change of Data Is to Be Checked               .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_DESIGN                    Sets the Design of the ALV Output                           .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_DISPLAY_TYPE              Sets the Type of Display, for Example Table, Hierarchy      .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Determines Whether Mode for Mass Data Is Activated          .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_EMPTY_TABLE_TEXT          Sets the Replacement Text for an Empty ALV Output           .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_ENABLED                   Activates the functional areas of the ALV output            .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_END_OF_LIST_VISIBLE       Shows the Design Object for the Footer Area                 .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW         Sets the First Visible Row                                  .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_FIRST_VISIBLE_SCROLL_COL  Determines First Scrollable Column                          .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_FIXED_TABLE_LAYOUT        Determines That Width of the ALV Output Is Indep. of Content.
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_FOOTER_VISIBLE            Shows the Footer with Pagination                            .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_GRID_MODE                 Determines Which Gridlines Are Displayed                    .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_READ_ONLY                 Sets the ALV Output as Write-Protected                      .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_REFRESH_ON_DATA_CHANGE    Controls Behavior of Refresh After Data Change              .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_REFRESH_ON_DATA_CHECK     Controls Behavior of Refresh After Data Change Check        .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_ROW_SELECTABLE            Deactivates Selectability of Rows in the ALV Output         .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_ROW_SELECTABLE_FIELDNAME  Determines Field for Selectability of Individual Rows       .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_SCROLLABLE_COL_COUNT      Determines Number of Scrollable Columns That Are Displayed  .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_SELECTION_MODE            Sets the Marking Type                                       .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_TOOLTIP                   Sets the Tooltip for the Entire ALV Output                  .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_TOP_OF_LIST_VISIBLE       Shows the Design Object for the Header Area                 .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_VISIBLE                   Shows or Hides the ALV Output                               .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_VISIBLE_ROW_COUNT         Sets the Height of the ALV Output in Rows                   .
IF_SALV_WD_TABLE_SETTINGS      I SET_WIDTH                     Sets the Width of the ALV Output                            .
IF_SAM_BYTES_MESSAGE           I GET_BYTES                     gets message data                                           .
IF_SAM_BYTES_MESSAGE           I SET_BYTES                     sets message data                                           .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I CLEAR_PROPERTIES              removes all properties                                      .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I GET_MESSAGE_TYPE              returns message type                                        .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I GET_PROPERTY_NAMES            get all property names                                      .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I GET_STRING_PROPERTY           gets a property                                             .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I PROPERTY_EXISTS               checks for property                                         .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I REMOVE_STRING_PROPERTY        removes a property                                          .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE                 I SET_STRING_PROPERTY           sets a property                                             .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_CONSUMER        I GET_MESSAGE_LISTENER          returns message listener                                    .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_CONSUMER        I RECEIVE                       wait next message                                           .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_CONSUMER        I RECEIVE_NO_WAIT               return next message                                         .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_CONSUMER        I SET_MESSAGE_LISTENER          sets message listener                                       .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_LISTENER        I ON_MESSAGE                    for asynchronous message delivery                           .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_QUEUE           I DEQUEUE_MESSAGE               dequeue message                                             .
IF_SAM_MESSAGE_QUEUE           I ENQUEUE_MESSAGE               enqueue message                                             .
IF_SAM_OBJECT_MESSAGE          I GET_OBJECT                    get message data                                            .
IF_SAM_OBJECT_MESSAGE          I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               returns type of message data                                .
IF_SAM_OBJECT_MESSAGE          I SET_OBJECT                    set message data                                            .
IF_SAM_QUEUE_RECEIVER          I GET_QUEUE                     returns the queue                                           .
IF_SAM_QUEUE_SENDER            I GET_QUEUE                     returns the queue                                           .
IF_SAM_QUEUE_SENDER            I SEND                          sends a message                                             .
IF_SAM_SERIALIZABLE            I DESERIALIZE                   initializes the instance from serialized representation     .
IF_SAM_SERIALIZABLE            I SERIALIZE                     returns serialized representation of the instance           .
IF_SAM_TEXT_MESSAGE            I GET_TEXT                      gets message data                                           .
IF_SAM_TEXT_MESSAGE            I SET_TEXT                      sets message data                                           .
IF_SATT_TABLE_MEMENTO          I GET_STATE                     Sets Stored Status for Transported Object                   .
IF_SATT_TABLE_MEMENTO          I SET_PREV_MEMENTO              Reverts to Previous Status                                  .
IF_SAT_OBJ_ASSIGN              I ASSIGN                        Assigns Objects to Specific Assignment Parameters           .
IF_SAT_OBJ_ASSIGN              I GET_POSSIBLE_ASSIGNMENTS      Returns Possible Assignments                                .
IF_SAVE_HRPAYIT_UR             I ROUND                         Rounding/truncating                                         .
IF_SAVE_REPLICA_INT            I VB_SAVE_REPLICA_INT           BAdI in FB BAPI_BATCH_SAVE_REPLICA                          .
IF_SA_DOC                      I ADD_TO_TRKORR                 Inserts Document in Transport Request                       .
IF_SA_DOC                      I CHECK_AND_SAVE                Checks for Changes and Saves if Requested by User           .
IF_SA_DOC                      I CHECK_CHANGED                 Checks for Document Changes                                 .
IF_SA_DOC                      I CLOSE                         Closes Document (Document Can Be Opened Again)              .
IF_SA_DOC                      I DELETE                        Deletes Document from Knowledge Warehouse                   .
IF_SA_DOC                      I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Info Object                                          .
IF_SA_DOC                      I DOWNLOAD                      Saves Document in Local File System                         .
IF_SA_DOC                      I ENQUEUE                       Lock Info Object                                            .
IF_SA_DOC                      I FREE                          Deletes Control in Container                                .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_FILE_EXT                  Provides File Type                                          .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_LOIO                      Returns Logical Info Object                                 .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_PREDECESSOR               Returns Predecessor of Copied Documents                     .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_PROPERTY                  Provides Property Value                                     .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_READONLY                  Provides Display Mode                                       .
IF_SA_DOC                      I GET_SLOIO                     Returns Structure for Logical Info Object                   .
IF_SA_DOC                      I IS_DOC_OPEN_IN_EDITOR         Was the document opened in the editor?                      .
IF_SA_DOC                      I LAUNCH                        Do not use; open inplace document instead                   .
IF_SA_DOC                      I OPEN_INPLACE                  Opens Inplace Document                                      .
IF_SA_DOC                      I PRINT                         Print Document                                              .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SAVE                          Saves Document in Knowledge Warehouse                       .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Attribute                                              .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SET_READONLY_MODE_OFF         Sets Change Mode                                            .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SET_READONLY_MODE_ON          Sets Change Mode                                            .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SET_STATUS                    Sets Document Status                                        .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SET_TITLE                     Sets Document Title                                         .
IF_SA_DOC                      I SHOW_ATTR_DIALOG              Display Attributes Dialog Box                               .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I CHECK_CHANGED                 Checks for Unsaved Internal Data                            .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I CHECK_FILE_EXTENSION          Gets file filter and binary flag for file ending            .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I CLEAR_CONTENT                 Deletes Content of Document                                 .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GENERATE_INITIAL_LOIO_ID      Create Initial LOIO ID                                      .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GENERATE_INITIAL_PHIO_ID      Create Initial PHIO ID                                      .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_AS_TABLE         Provides Document in Form of Internal Table                 .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_FILENAME         Provides File Name of Document                              .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_FORMAT           Provides File Extension of Document                         .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_FULL_PATH        Returns Path and File Name                                  .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_MIMETYPE         Provides MIME Type of Document                              .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_SIZE             Provides Document Size                                      .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_DOCUMENT_SRC              Provides Document Source                                    .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_INITIAL_LOIO_ID           Read Initial LOIO ID                                        .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_INIT_ATT_VALUE            Gets Current Document Attributes                            .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_LOIO                      Read LOIO                                                   .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_NEW_ATT_VALUE             Gets Current Document Attributes                            .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_PHIO                      Returns Physical Info Object                                .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_PHIOS                     Gets all PHIOS (Restriction via Properties is Possible)     .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_READ_URL                  Provides URL to Call Up Document                            .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I GET_WRITE_URL                 Provides URL to Edit Document                               .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I IS_EXTERNAL_URL               Provides Content for External URL                           .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I REMOVE_INITIAL_IDS            Remove Initial PHIO and LOIO                                .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_DOCUMENT_AS_TABLE         Removes Document from Internal Table                        .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_DOCUMENT_AS_URL           Sets Document as URL                                        .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_DOCUMENT_SIZE             Sets Size of Document                                       .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_INIT_ATT_VALUE            Gets the Document Attribute                                 .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_IO                        Sets the Info Object Data for Content                       .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I SET_NEW_ATT_VALUE             Sets the Document Attribute                                 .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I STORE_DOCUMENT                Saves Current Document in Knowledge Warehouse               .
IF_SA_DOC_CONT                 I UPLOAD_DOCUMENT               Loads the Document from File System                         .
IF_SA_IO                       I CHECK_CHANGED                 Checks for Unsaved Data                                     .
IF_SA_IO                       I CLEAR_CONTENT                 Deletes Content of Document                                 .
IF_SA_IO                       I DELETE_IO                     Deletes Info Object from Knowledge Wrehouse                 .
IF_SA_IO                       I DEQUEUE_IO                    Unlock Info Object                                          .
IF_SA_IO                       I ENQUEUE_IO                    Lock Info Object                                            .
IF_SA_IO                       I FREE                          Clean Up Without Saving                                     .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_AREA                      Provides Document Data                                      .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_CLASS                     Provides Document Class                                     .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_CONTEXT                   Returns Current Context                                     .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_DOCUMENT_AS_TABLE         Provides Document as Internal Table                         .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_DOCUMENT_FILENAME         Document Content in SAP Solution Manager                    .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_DOCUMENT_FULL_PATH        Returns Path and File Name                                  .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_FILE_EXT                  Provides File Type                                          .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_FOLDER                    Provides Folder                                             .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_FOLDER_GROUP              Gets the Folder Group                                       .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_IO                        Provides Info Object                                        .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_MIMETYPE                  Provides MIME Type of Document                              .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_PHIO                      Gets the Physical Object                                    .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_PREDECESSOR               Provides Info Object                                        .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_PROPERTIES                Returns All Attributes                                      .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_PROPERTY                  Returns Specific Attribute                                  .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_READONLY                  Provides Display Mode                                       .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_READ_URL                  Provides URL to Call Up Document                            .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_SIZE                      Provides Document Size                                      .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_STRUCTURE                 Provides Structure for Info Object                          .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_TECHNAME                  Provides Attribute 'TECH_NAME'                              .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_TITLE                     Provides Attribute 'Description'                            .
IF_SA_IO                       I GET_WRITE_URL                 Provides URL to Edit Document                               .
IF_SA_IO                       I IS_EXTERNAL_URL               Supplies Document to External URL                           .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_CONTENT_HAS_CHANGED       Sets Attribute                                              .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_CONTEXT                   Changes Transferred Data in Current Context                 .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_DOCUMENT_AS_TABLE         Removes Document from Internal Table                        .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_DOCUMENT_AS_URL           Sets Document as URL                                        .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets All Attributes                                         .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Attribute                                              .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_READONLY_MODE_OFF         Sets Change Mode                                            .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_READONLY_MODE_ON          Sets Change Mode                                            .
IF_SA_IO                       I SET_SIZE                      Sets Size of Document                                       .
IF_SA_IO                       I SHOW_ATTR_DIALOG              Display Attributes Dialog Box                               .
IF_SA_IO                       I STORE_DOCUMENT                Saves Current Document in Knowledge Warehouse               .
IF_SA_IO                       I UPLOAD_DOCUMENT               Loads the Document from File System                         .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_CONTEXT_MENU              Fill Context Menu for Migration Element                     .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_MIGHELP_REQUEST           Return Navigation Request for Migration Help                .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_MIGRATION_PROPOSAL        Proposal for Migration                                      .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_MIGRATION_STATE           Get Migration Status of Element                             .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_SOURCE_REQUEST            Return Navigation Request for Source of Element             .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I GET_TARGET_REQUEST            Return Navigation Request for Migration Target              .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I MIGRATE                       Migrate                                                     .
IF_SBMIG_ELEMENT               I SET_MIGRATION_STATE           Set Migration Status of Element                             .
IF_SBTI_CRITERIA_ITEM          I CRITERIA_GET                  Returns the criteria table for the selected field           .
IF_SBTI_CRITERIA_ITEM          I CRITERIA_SET                  Sets the criteria table for the selected field              .
IF_SBTI_CRITERIA_ITEM          I DESCRIPTION_GET               Gets parameter                                              .
IF_SBTI_CRITERIA_ITEM          I DESCRIPTION_SET               Modifies parameter                                          .
IF_SBTI_CRITERIA_PROFILE       I DESCRIPTION_SET               Modifies Description                                        .
IF_SB_COSTING_COMPONENT_CK     I GET_CCS                       Returns Layers                                              .
IF_SB_COSTING_COMPONENT_CK     I GET_PRICES                    Returns Price Table                                         .
IF_SCMC_ABAP_DUMP              I GET_ADUMPS                    Returns a Table with References to Elements                 .
IF_SCMC_ORACLE_BACKUP_STATUS   I GET_LAST_BR_BACKUP_RUN        Last brbackup Run                                           .
IF_SCMC_ORACLE_BACKUP_STATUS   I GET_LAST_SUCC_COMPLETE_BACKUP Last Successful Complete Database Backup                    .
IF_SCMC_ORACLE_SEGMENT         I GET_SEGM_WITH_NON_ZERO_INCR   Segments with Non-Zero Increase                             .
IF_SCMC_PARAMETER              I IS_THRESH_UP                  True, if direction is from left to right                    .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_MSG              I GET_MSG                       Read Text Message                                           .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_THRESH_G2Y                Threshold Value from Green to Yellow                        .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_THRESH_R2Y                Threshold Value from Red to Yellow                          .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_THRESH_Y2G                Threshold Value from Yellow to Green                        .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_THRESH_Y2R                Threshold Value from Yellow to Red                          .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_UNIT                      Name of Measurement Unit                                    .
IF_SCMC_PARAM_VALUE            I GET_VALUE                     Read Measured Value                                         .
IF_SCMG_ACTION_PROF_SRCH_BADI  I GET_SELOPTS                   get selection options for search help                       .
IF_SCMG_ARCHIVABLE             I INIT                          Register Classes & Structures Here.                         .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE              I GET_CASE_GUID                 Returns Corresponding Entry from the SCMG_T_CASE Table.     .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE              I GET_CASE_POIDID               Returns Corresponding Entry from the POID Directory.        .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_ATTRIBUTES_CONTENTS       Returns Contents of SCMG_T_CASE_ATTR Table.                 .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_CASE_CONTENTS             Returns Contents of SCMG_T_CASE Table.                      .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_CUSTOMATTR_CONTENTS       Returns Contents of the Customized Attributes Table.        .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_CUSTOMATTR_TNAME          Returns Name of the Customized Attributes Table.            .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_POID_DIRECTORY_TNAME      Returns Name of the POID Directory Table.                   .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_POID_RELATIONS_TNAME      Returns Name of the POID Relations Table.                   .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_RELATIONS_CONTENTS        Returns Contents of POID Relations Table.                   .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_CASE_DETAIL       I GET_SUBCOMPONENT_LIST         Returns List of Subcomponent's fcodes.                      .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_DATA              I GET_ARCHIVE_HANDLE            Returns Archive Handle for the Archiving Session.           .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_DATA              I GET_DELETE_FLAG               Returns Delete Flag.                                        .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_ERASER            I GET_TABLEDATA_BY_NAME         Returns Contents of the Table, Already Read from Archive.   .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_FACTORY           I GET_ARCH_DATA                 Returns instance of archiving data. Initial if normal DB    .
IF_SCMG_ARCH_SEQUENCE          I GET_LIST_OF_SUBCOMPONENTS     Returns List of fcodes.                                     .
IF_SCMG_ATTRIBUTE_DATASOURCE   I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns Attributes of the Case                              .
IF_SCMG_ATTRIBUTE_DATASOURCE   I REFRESH                       Reloads Data                                                .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I DISPLAY                       Display Attributes                                          .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I GET_INSTANCE                  Factory                                                     .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I GET_SCREEN_VALUES             Get Attribute Values from Display                           .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I GET_SELOPTION                 Get Selection Options From Display                          .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I SET_CURSOR                    Position Cursor on Attribute                                .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Switch Between Create, Display, Change                      .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I SET_PROPERTIES                Change Display Properties                                   .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I SET_SCREEN_VALUES             Send Attribute Values to Display                            .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I SET_SELOPTION                 Copy Selection Options to Display                           .
IF_SCMG_ATTR_DISPLAY           I UPDATE_DROP_DOWN              Update Dropdown Values for Attribute                        .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION          I CHECK_ACTIVITY                Ascertain Original Key of Relevant Object                   .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION          I CHECK_ACTIVITY_FIELD          Check Authorization on Field Level                          .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION          I GET_INSTANCE                  Create Instance                                             .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION          I RESET_BUFFER                  Reset Buffer from External Location                         .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION_CALLER   I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Attribute Return                                            .
IF_SCMG_AUTHORIZATION_CALLER   I GET_PROCESS                   Prozess Supported by the Case                               .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I BEFORE_STORE                  Functions Before Saving Case                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I COPY_CASE                     Case Copy                                                   .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I DELETE                        Delete Case                                                 .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I EDIT_ATTRIBUTES               Returns List of Case Attributes                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I FREE_OBJECTS                  Release Attributes Like CL_SCMG_CASE_ATTRIBUTE              .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Case. Call only when the case is created         .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I INITIALIZE_SUBCOMPONENTS      Initialize Case Subcomponents                               .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I IS_VALID_BEFORE_STORE         Case consistent?                                            .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I MERGE_CASES                   Merge Cases                                                 .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I MODEL_TO_INSTANCE_POID        The Case Model POID is Being Converted to an Instance POID  .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SAVE_PROTOCOL                 Save Log Entries                                            .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SET_NOTE_POID                 Set Note POID                                               .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SET_RECORD_POID               Set Record POID                                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SET_SINGLE_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    Set Single Attribute                                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SET_WF_PATH_ID                Set Process Route ID                                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I SPLIT_CASE                    Split case into another one or two                          .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I STORE                         Save Case                                                   .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I UNDO_ATTRIBUTE_CHANGES        Attributes Set to Last Persistent State                     .
IF_SCMG_CASE                   I WRITE_PROTOCOL_ENTRY          Write Log Entry                                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ATTRIBUTE_ALL_GET             Read All Attributes                                         .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ATTRIBUTE_CHANGE              Case: Change Attribute                                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ATTRIBUTE_GET                 Case: Read Attribute                                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I AUTHORITY_CHECK_FIELD         Check Authorization for Field Access                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I BOR_OBJECTS_GET               Get All BOR Objects (for a Specific Anchor)                 .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I BOR_OBJECT_DELETE             Delete BOR Object in Case Record (ID or Anchor/BOR Object)  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I BOR_OBJECT_INSERT             Insert BOR Object in the Case Record                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I CLOSE_CASE                    Completely Close Case After Processing                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I COPY_CASE                     Case: Copy                                                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I CREATE                        Case: Create                                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I DELETE                        Case: Delete                                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Case                                                 .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ELEMENT_DELETE                Delete Element in Case Record (ID or Anchor)                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ELEMENT_INSERT                Insert Element in Record Anchor                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I ENQUEUE                       Lock Case                                                   .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I FIND_CASES_BY_ATTRIBUTE       Find Cases with Specified Attributes                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I FIND_CASES_BY_ATTR_RANGES     Gets GUIDs of Cases with Specified Attributes               .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I FIND_CASES_BY_BOR_OBJECT      Find Cases with Specified BOR Object                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_ALL_OBJECTS               Get Objects from Case Record                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_ALL_SUBCOMPONENTS         Creates Instances for Subcomponents of Case                 .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_BACKEND_CASE              Get Case Back End                                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_BACKEND_NOTES             Get Notes Back End                                          .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_BACKEND_RECORD            Get Record Back End                                         .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_BACKEND_WF_PATH           Get Route API                                               .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_BACKEND_WF_STATE          Determine Process Route Status                              .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_CASE                      Create Case API Object (Obsolete)                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_CASE_TEXT                 Read terminology: default: text "case"                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_INSTANCES_FOR_REC_ANCHOR  Return GUIDs of Object Instances for Specified Anchor       .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_LINKED_OBJECTS            Get Objects from Case Record                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_RECORD_OPEN               Read: Case Record Opened                                    .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I GET_VICINITY                  Return GUIDs of Supercases and Subcases for the Current Case.
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I LOG_READ                      Read Log                                                    .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I LOG_WRITE                     Write log                                                   .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I MERGE_CASES                   Merge Two Cases into One (New or Existing)                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I NOTES_GET                     Read notes                                                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I NOTE_INSERT                   Case: Insert Note                                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I OPEN_CASE                     Create Case API Object                                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I SAVE                          Case: Save                                                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I SET_CLIENT_FRAMWORK_ID        Set Client Framework ID (If Not Default Framework           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I SET_ROOT_OBJECT               Set Root Object (Before First GET)                          .
IF_SCMG_CASE_API               I SPLIT_CASE                    Split Case into New One or Two Cases                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I CHECK_AUTHORITY_FIELD         Authorization Check at Field Level                          .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Returns List of Case Attributes                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_CASE_TYPE                 Returns Case Type                                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_CREATING_USER             User Who Created Case                                       .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_CREATION_DATE             UTC Timestamp when Case Created                             .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Case Title                                                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_GUID                      Returns Case GUID                                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_LAST_CHANGE_DATE          UTC Timestamp of Last Change                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_LAST_CHANGING_USER        User Who Last Changed Case                                  .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_NOTE_POID                 Returns POID Object of Notes                                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_PROCESS                   Process that Maps Case                                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_RECORD_POID               Returns POID Object of Record                               .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_SINGLE_ATTRIBUTE          Returns Attribute Object                                    .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_SINGLE_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    Returns Value of Single Attribute                           .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_SINGLE_OLD_ATTR_VALUE     Returns Last Persistent Values of Attributes                .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_SINGLE_VALUE              Returns Single Value                                        .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_STATUS_AS_TEXT            Text of Current Status                                      .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_SUBCOMPONENTS             Retunes Subcomponents                                       .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_WF_PATH                   Get the Workflow Path                                       .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I GET_WF_PATH_ID                Returns Workflow Path ID                                    .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I IS_CHANGED                    Attributes changed?                                         .
IF_SCMG_CASE_READ              I IS_VALID                      Attributes consistent?                                      .
IF_SCMG_DOC_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTIES                Getting Properties                                          .
IF_SCMG_DOC_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY                  Getting Property                                            .
IF_SCMG_DOC_PROPERTY           I GET_PROPERTY_TYPES            Description of Properties                                   .
IF_SCMG_MASS_ACTIVITY          I EXECUTE                       Mass Activity                                               .
IF_SCMG_PRINT                  I GET_PRINT_DATA                Get Data to Be Printed                                      .
IF_SCMG_REC_EMBD_CASE          I GET_RECORD_MODEL              Record Model for Record                                     .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_CLIENT         I PRINT_CASE                    Print Case                                                  .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_CLIENT         I RESET_CONTXT_ATTR_BUFFER      Initializes the attribute gt_context_attributes             .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I ADD_PROT_LINE                 Add Log Line                                                .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I ADD_TEXT                      Get New Text                                                .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I CHANGE_LAST_TEXT              Offer Last Text for Changing                                .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Existing Text                                        .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I CREATE_NOTE                   Set GUID for New Text Notes                                 .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I DELETE_SINGLE_TEXT            Delete a Text for the Case                                  .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I DELETE_TEXTS                  Delete All Texts for Case                                   .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GENERATE_NOTE_KEY             Creates a complete key for a new note                       .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_CONNECTION_PARA           Read Connection Parameter                                   .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_CONTEXT_PARA              Read Context Parameter                                      .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_FLAG_CHANGED              Flag: Do Changes Exist?                                     .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_SPPOID_PARA               Read POID Parameter                                         .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_TEXTS                     Read texts                                                  .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_TEXT_PROF_FROM_CONN_PARA  Read Text Profile via Connection Parameter                  .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I GET_TEXT_TYPES                Read Text Types                                             .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I REFRESH_TEXTS                 Delete Texts from the Case Notes Buffer                     .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I SAVE_TEXTS                    Save Added Texts                                            .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I SET_ARCH_DATA                 Archiving: Insert Archiving Data                            .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I SET_CONTEXT_PARA              Set Context Parameter                                       .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I SET_SPPOID_PARA               Set POID Parameter                                          .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_BACKEND  I UNDO_TEXTS                    Remove Added Texts                                          .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I ADD_NEW_TEXT                  Add New Text                                                .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I BUILD_VISUALIZATION           Create User Interface                                       .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I CHANGE_EDITOR                 Change Editor (SAPScript)                                   .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I CHANGE_LAST_TEXT              Change Last Text                                            .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I CHANGE_TEXT_TYPE              Change Text Type                                            .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I DISPLAY_TEXTS                 Display texts                                               .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I GET_FLAG_CHANGED              Flag: Do Changes Exist?                                     .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I GET_NEW_TEXT                  Read New text                                               .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I GET_TEXT_TYPE                 Read Text Type of New Text                                  .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I MODIFY_TEXTS                  Create new texts                                            .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I REFRESH_TEXTS                 Refresh Displayed Texts                                     .
IF_SCMG_SP_CASE_NOTES_CLIENT   I UNDO_CHANGES                  Revoke changes                                              .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I ANSWER_ON_REQUEST             Assign Answer to Sent Request                               .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I DELETE                        Delete Subcomponent                                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I DEQUEUE                       Unlock object                                               .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I DISPLAY                       Case Subcomponent: Display                                  .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I FINISH                        Case Finished - Finish Subcomponent                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I GET_NEW_INSTANCE              Create New Object                                           .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I IS_CHANGED                    Subcomponent Data Changed Since Save?                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I MODIFY                        Change                                                      .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I PRINT                         Print                                                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT           I SET_BUTTON                    Set Data for Pushbutton in Menu (Checked)                   .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I DELETE                        Delete Subcomponent                                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I GET_API                       Returns existing API of subcomponent                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I GET_NEW_INSTANCE              Generate New Object from API                                .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I GET_POID                      Returns POID for subcomponent if SP; otherwise empty        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I GET_TYPE                      Returns type of subcomponent                                .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I MERGE                         Merge Subcomponents                                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I SAVE                          Saves Changes to Subcomponents                              .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_API       I SPLIT                         Split subcomponent into another one or two                  .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I DELETE                        Delete Subcomponent                                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I GET_API                       Returns existing API of subcomponent                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I GET_FRONTEND                  Returns the Front End of the Subcomponent                   .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I GET_NEW_INSTANCE              Create New Object                                           .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I GET_POID                      Returns POID for subcomponent if SP; otherwise empty        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I GET_TYPE                      Returns type of subcomponent                                .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I IS_CHANGED                    Has the subcomponent data changed since saving?             .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I MERGE                         Merge                                                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I SET_CHANGED                   Subcomponent Changed (yes/no=x/space)                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_BACKEND   I SPLIT                         Split                                                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I ANSWER_ON_REQUEST             Assign Answer to Sent Request                               .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I DEQUEUE                       Unlock object                                               .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I DISPLAY                       Case Subcomponent: Display                                  .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I FINISH                        Case Finished - Finish Subcomponent                         .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I MODIFY                        Change                                                      .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I PRINT                         Print                                                       .
IF_SCMG_SUBCOMPONENT_FRONTEND  I SET_BUTTON                    Set Data for Pushbutton in Menu (Checked)                   .
IF_SCP_RANGE_CALCULATION       I MAX                           Maximum amount                                              .
IF_SCP_RANGE_CALCULATION       I MIN                           Minimum Value                                               .
IF_SCP_RANGE_CALCULATION       I NEXT                          Next value                                                  .
IF_SCP_RANGE_CALCULATION       I PREV                          Previous value                                              .
IF_SDC_PROPS_CONVERSION        I CONVERSION_INPUT              Conversion of External Representation to Interal Rep.       .
IF_SDC_PROPS_CONVERSION        I CONVERSION_OUTPUT             Conversion of External Representation to Interal Rep.       .
IF_SDOK_CF_ATTRIBUTE           I GET_ATTR_NAME                 Name of IO Attribute                                        .
IF_SDOK_CF_ATTRIBUTE           I GET_TYPE                      Type of IO Object (LOIO|PHIO) to which IO Attrib. is Connect.
IF_SDOK_CF_ATTRIBUTE           I GET_VALUE                     Return Attribute Value from XML Content                     .
IF_SDOK_CF_ATTRIBUTE           I SET_VALUE                     Set Attribute Value in XML Content                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_ATTR_BY_NAME              iXML Attribute of the Current Config Node                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_ID                        ID Attribute of the Current Config Node                     .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_INFOCLASS                 Infoclass Definition of the Current Config Node from Config .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_IXML_NODES_BY_NAME        iXML Node Set for the Current Config Node According to XPath.
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_PATTERN                   Pattern Definition of Current Config Node from Config       .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_TYPE                      Type of Current Config Node (Fragment, UnparsedObj, ...)    .
IF_SDOK_CF_ELEMENT             I GET_VALUE                     Value of Element "Value" from Configuration                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I GET_DECLARATION               GET_DECLARATION                                             .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I GET_INFOOBJECT                GET_INFOOBJECT                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I GET_NAME                      Return Name of Entity Ref                                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I GET_REF_DESCRIPTION           GET_REF_DESCRIPTION                                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I RESOLVE                       RESOLVE                                                     .
IF_SDOK_CF_ENTITY_REF          I SET_NAME                      Set Name of Entity Ref                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I APPEND_LINK                   Create Reference for Specified Node                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_ATTR_LIST                 Return IO Attribute (Acc. to Config)                        .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_CONFIG_ELEMENT            Return the Assigned Config Element                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS         Return Default Info Class (Acc. to Config)                  .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_INFOCLASS                 Return Assigned Info Class (Acc. to Config)                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_INFOOBJECT                Return Assigned Info Object                                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I GET_NODES_BY_TYPE             Return Node Set                                             .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT            I RENDER                        Render DOM-"OutputStream                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT_REF        I GET_ENTITY_NAME               GET_ENTITY_NAME                                             .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT_REF        I GET_FRAGMENT                  GET_FRAGMENT                                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT_REF        I GET_INFOOBJECT                GET_INFOOBJECT                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT_REF        I GET_REF_DESCRIPTION           GET_REF_DESCRIPTION                                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_FRAGMENT_REF        I SET_ENTITY_NAME               SET_ENTITY_NAME                                             .
IF_SDOK_CF_HYPERLINK           I GET_CONFIG_ELEMENT            Return Corresponding Config Element                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_HYPERLINK           I GET_INFOOBJECT                GET_INFOOBJECT                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_HYPERLINK           I GET_LINK                      GET_LINK                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_HYPERLINK           I SET_LINK                      SET_LINK                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOCLASS           I GET_LOIO_CLASS_NAME           Name of LOIO Class According to Config                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOCLASS           I GET_PHIO_CLASS_NAME           Name of PHIO Class Accroding to Config                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I ADD_RELATION                  ADD_RELATION                                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_CLASS                     GET_CLASS                                                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_CONTENT_SUBTYPE           GET_CONTENT_SUBTYPE                                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              GET_CONTENT_TYPE                                            .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_FILE_NAME                 Return Reference Name                                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_GUID                      GET_GUID                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_RELATION_COUNTER          Number of the Relation (Cross-Relationship Class)           .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I GET_RELATION_NAME             Name of Relationship Class                                  .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I SET_CLASS                     GET_CLASS                                                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I SET_FILE_NAME                 Set File Name                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT          I SET_GUID                      GET_GUID                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT_RULE     I GET_ATTR_NAME                 GET_ATTR_NAME                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_INFOOBJECT_RULE     I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_MATCH               I GET_CONFIG_ELEMENT            Return the Assigned Config Element                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_MATCH               I GET_VALUE                     Return Values from the XML Content                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_MATCH               I GET_VALUE_BY_EXPRESSION       Returns Value of XPath Expression                           .
IF_SDOK_CF_MATCH               I INSERT_FRAGMENT_BODY          Insert iXML Tree Below the Match Node                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_MATCH               I SET_VALUE                     Set Value in XML Content                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I CREATE_FRAGMENT               CREATE_FRAGMENT                                             .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I CREATE_REFERENCE              CREATE_REFERENCE                                            .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I CREATE_REF_DESCRIPTION        CREATE_REF_DESCRIPTION                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I CREATE_ROOT_FRAGMENT          CREATE_ROOT_FRAGMENT                                        .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_ATTR_LIST                 GET_ATTR_LIST                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_CONFIG_ELEMENT            Return the Assigned Config Element                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS         GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS                                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_INFOCLASS                 GET_INFOCLASS                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_INFOOBJECT                GET_INFOOBJECT                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I GET_VALUE_BY_PATTERN          GET_VALUE_BY_PATTERN                                        .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I PROCESS_ENTITYREF_NODE        PROCESS_ENTITYREF_NODE                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I PROCESS_HYPERLINK_NODE        PROCESS_HYPERLINK_NODE                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I PROCESS_MATCH_NODE            PROCESS_MATCH_NODE                                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I PROCESS_UNPARSEDOBJECT_NODE   PROCESS_UNPARSEDOBJECT_NODE                                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODE                I SET_VALUE_BY_PATTERN          SET_VALUE_BY_PATTERN                                        .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODESET             I APPEND_ITEM                   Add New IF_SDOK_CF_NODE Node                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODESET             I GET_LENGTH                    Return Number of Nodes in Node Set                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODESET             I GET_NEXT                      Return Next IF_SDOK_CF_NODE Node                            .
IF_SDOK_CF_NODESET             I RESET                         Set Node Pointer at Beginning of Node et                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_PATTERN             I BUILD_EXPRESSION              Build XPath Expression According to Pattern: Elem[@Attrib]  .
IF_SDOK_CF_PATTERN             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_NAME            Determine Value of "Pattern/Attribute" Node from Config     .
IF_SDOK_CF_PATTERN             I GET_ELEMENT_NAME              Determine Value of "Pattern/Element" Node from Config       .
IF_SDOK_CF_PATTERN             I GET_NAMESPACES                Determine Used Name Spaces from the Pattern                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I GET_DESCRIPTION_FORMAT        GET_DESCRIPTION_FORMAT                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I GET_DESCRIPTION_SOURCE        GET_DESCRIPTION_SOURCE                                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I GET_LANGUAGE                  GET_LANGUAGE                                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I GET_VALUE                     GET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I SET_LANGUAGE                  SET_LANGUAGE                                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_REF_DESCR           I SET_VALUE                     SET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I ASSIGN_CONFIG_ID              Assign Fragment ID to XML Document                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I CHECK_CONFIG                  Check Config Document                                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I CREATE_REVERSE_ITERATOR       Retrieve Sorted IF_SDOK_CF_NODE Node Set (Acc. to Config)   .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I FLATTEN_INTERNAL_REFERENCES   Compare Internal Entity Names                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GENERATE_REFERENCE_NAME       Assign Name for New Fragment Reference                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_ASSIGNED_CONFIG_ID        Query Fragment ID Assigned to Document                      .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_CONFIG_CHECK_MODE         Query Check Mode                                            .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_DECLARATION_CATALOG       Global Catalog of Entity Declarations                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS         Determine Name of Default Info Class Acc. to Config         .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_DOCUMENT_DOCTYPE          Set "!DOCTYPE" for Document                                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_DOCUMENT_INFOOBJECT       Query IO Class ans IO GUID of XML Document                  .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_LOG_MODE                  Query Log Mode                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_NODES_FOR_PATTERN         Use Pattern Object on XML Document                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_REF_DESCRIPTION_MODE      Query Current Mode                                          .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GET_RESOLVED_DOCUMENT         Resolve Entities in XML Document                            .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I GUESS_CONFIG_ID               Guess Config ID According to LOIO/PHIO Classes              .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I IS_VALIDATING                 Determine Validation Mode for XML Document from Config      .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I PROCESS_DOCUMENT              Fragmentation and Relationship Creation                     .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_CONFIG_CHECK_MODE         Set Check Mode (Strict or Ignore)                           .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_CONFIG_SOURCE_DOM         Load Config in DOM Format into Object                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_CONFIG_SOURCE_XSTRING     Load Config in XSTRING Format into Object                   .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_DECLARATION_CATALOG       Global Catalog of Entity Declarations                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_DOCUMENT_DOCTYPE          Set "!DOCTYPE" for Document                                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_DOCUMENT_INFOOBJECT       Add IO Class and IO GUID of the XML Document                .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_DOCUMENT_SOURCE_DOM       Load XML Document in DOM Format into Object                 .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_DOCUMENT_SOURCE_XSTRING   Load XML Document in XSTRING Format into Object             .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_LOG_MODE                  Set Log Mode                                                .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_REF_DESCRIPTION_MODE      Insert/Remove Description of External Entity References     .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I SET_STYLESHEET_SOURCE_XSTRING Load XSLT Stylesheet in XSTRING Format into Object          .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I TRANSFORM_DOCUMENT            Apply XSLT Stylesheet to Document                           .
IF_SDOK_CF_RUNTIME             I VALIDATE_DOCUMENT             Validate Document                                           .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_ATTR_LIST                 GET_ATTR_LIST                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_CONFIG_ELEMENT            Return Corresponding Config Element                         .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS         GET_DEFAULT_INFOCLASS                                       .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_INFOCLASS                 GET_INFOCLASS                                               .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_INFOOBJECT                GET_INFOOBJECT                                              .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I GET_LINK                      GET_LINK                                                    .
IF_SDOK_CF_UNPARSED            I SET_LINK                      SET_LINK                                                    .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I CLEAR                         Delete Index Contents                                       .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I DELETE                        Delete Index Completely                                     .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I EXISTS_INDEX                  Does Index Exist?                                           .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get Description                                             .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I GET_FULLTEXT_KEY              Generates the Full Text Key for a Data Record               .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I GET_LAST_ERROR_CODE           Get Error Code                                              .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I GET_LAST_ERROR_TEXT           Get Error Text                                              .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I INDEX                         Indexes Data Records                                        .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I MODIFY                        Create or Change an Index                                   .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I OPTIMIZE                      Build Full Text Indices                                     .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_INDEX         I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set Description                                             .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_JOIN          I DELETE_JOIN                   Deletes a Join Index                                        .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_JOIN          I GET_PROPERTY                  Gets the Join Attributes                                    .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_JOIN          I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets the Join Attributes                                    .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_MONITOR       I GET_ALV_FCAT                  Generates FCAT for ALV Grid                                 .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_MONITOR       I GET_ALV_TITLE                 Generates Title for ALV Grid                                .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_MONITOR       I GET_ITEMS_INFO                Returns Information on Indices or Catalogs                  .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_MONITOR       I GET_ITEMS_STRUCTURE_NAME      Returns the Structure Name for the Index Info               .
IF_SEARCH_ENGINE_MONITOR       I PING                          Checks Whether Search Engine is Available                   .
IF_SECSTORE_HANDLER            I CHECK_RECORD                  Check Entry                                                 .
IF_SECSTORE_HANDLER            I GET_APPLICATION_DETAILS       Detail Data for Application                                 .
IF_SECSTORE_HANDLER            I GET_RECORD_DETAILS            Detail Data for an Entry                                    .
IF_SECSTORE_HANDLER            I NAVIGATE_TO_RECORD            Navigation to an Entry                                      .
IF_SECSTORE_HANDLER_710        I DELETE_RECORD_NOTIFY          Entry is being deleted                                      .
IF_SELECTABLE_DIF              I GET_SELECTOR                  Supplies Flow Selector                                      .
IF_SELECTABLE_DIF              I PRINT                         Display in Report                                           .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I COMMIT                        Write Data to the Database                                  .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I DEBUG                         Debugging Mode                                              .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I GET                           Read Data Without Copying                                   .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I INIT_UNDO                     Init Undo                                                   .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I READ                          Read data                                                   .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I REFRESH                       Refresh Buffer and Unlock                                   .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I SAVE                          Write Data                                                  .
IF_SEM_BUFFER                  I UNDO                          Undo                                                        .
IF_SEM_CHALEV                  I GET_INTERSECTION              Intersection of Two Levels                                  .
IF_SEM_CHALEV                  I IS_CONTAINING_CHA             Contains Characteristic?                                    .
IF_SEM_CHALEV                  I IS_CONTAINING_CHALEV          Contains Different Level?                                   .
IF_SEM_CHALEV                  I IS_EQUAL                      Is Equal to a Different Level?                              .
IF_SEM_CHALEV                  I MASK                          Delete Characteristic Values                                .
IF_SEM_CHASEL                  I DEQUEUE                       Unlock                                                      .
IF_SEM_CHASEL                  I ENQUEUE                       Lock                                                        .
IF_SEM_CHASEL                  I IS_CONTAINING_CHAS            Characteristic combination contained in selection?          .
IF_SEM_CHASEL                  I IS_CONTAINING_CHASEL          Includes Other Selection Condition?                         .
IF_SEM_CHASEL                  I IS_EQUAL                      Is the Same as Other Selection Condition?                   .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I ADD                           Add                                                         .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I COMPRESS                      Collapse                                                    .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I DECOMPRESS                    Decompress                                                  .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I GET_DATA                      Get data                                                    .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I READ                          Read Data From Buffer                                       .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I SAVE                          Update Data in Buffer                                       .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I SET_DATA                      Transfer data                                               .
IF_SEM_DATA                    I SUBTRACT                      Subtract                                                    .
IF_SEM_DATASPLT                I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_SEM_DATASPLT                I NEXT                          Next Package                                                .
IF_SEM_DATA_INTERNAL           I DERIVE                        Characteristic derivation                                   .
IF_SEM_DATA_INTERNAL           I READ_DB                       Read database data                                          .
IF_SEM_DATA_INTERNAL           I SAVE_DB                       Export data                                                 .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_CHALEV                 Generate Characteristic Level                               .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_CHASEL                 Generate Characteristic Selection                           .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_DATA                   Generate Plan Data                                          .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_DATASPLT               Generate Package Screens                                    .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_DATA_INTERNAL          Generate Plan Data                                          .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I CREATE_KYFLEV                 Generate Key Figure Level                                   .
IF_SEM_FACTORY                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_SEM_KYFLEV                  I IS_CONTAINING_KYF             Contains Key Figure?                                        .
IF_SEM_KYFLEV                  I IS_CONTAINING_KYFLEV          Contains Other Key Figure Level                             .
IF_SEM_KYFLEV                  I IS_EQUAL                      Is the Same as Another Key Figure Level                     .
IF_SEM_KYFLEV                  I MASK                          Delete Key Figures                                          .
IF_SENDER_BCS                  I ADDRESS_NAME                  Returns Display Name of Sender                              .
IF_SENDER_BCS                  I ADDRESS_STRING                Returns Address String of Sender                            .
IF_SENDER_BCS                  I ADDRESS_TYPE                  Returns Address Type of Sender                              .
IF_SERIALIZABLE_MM             I READ_FROM                     Read Data                                                   .
IF_SERIALIZABLE_MM             I WRITE_TO                      Write Data                                                  .
IF_SERVICES_MM                 I GET_DATA                      Get Data                                                    .
IF_SERVICES_MM                 I GET_SRV_DATA                  Get Service Data                                            .
IF_SERVICES_MM                 I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_SERVICE_OPERATION_POC       I EXECUTE                       Execute Service                                             .
IF_SESH_CON_METADATA           I GET_ALTERNATIVE_QUERIES       Get alternative queries for a given object type             .
IF_SESH_CON_METADATA           I GET_NAVIGATION_TARGETS        Get the navigation targets per object type                  .
IF_SESH_CON_METADATA           I GET_OBJECT_TYPES              Get the list of available object types with display names   .
IF_SESH_CON_METADATA           I GET_OBJECT_TYPE_ATTRS         Get the attributes of an object type for its standard query .
IF_SESH_CON_METADATA           I GET_RELATED_OBJECT_TYPES      Get the related object types to a given object type         .
IF_SESH_CON_SEARCH             I EXECUTE_SEARCH                Execute a search in this search service provider            .
IF_SET_APPLICATION             I SET_APPLICATION               Set Application for General Ledger                          .
IF_SET_DEFPPRCTR               I SET_DEFAULT_PART_PRCTR        Set Default Partner Profit Center                           .
IF_SET_DEFPRCTR                I SET_DEFAULTPRCTR              Set a Default Profit Center                                 .
IF_SFW_CHECK_SFW5              I CHECK_SINGLE_BF               Check whether a business function can be activated          .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I ADD_SWITCH                    Adds a Switch to the Check                                  .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I ADD_SWITCHES                  Adds a List of Switches                                     .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I CHECK                         Starts Checks                                               .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I GET_RESULTS                   Returns the Results of a Check                              .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I GET_SWITCHES                  Returns the Switches to Be Checked                          .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I REMOVE_ALL_SWITCHES           Deletes All Switches                                        .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I REMOVE_SWITCH                 Deletes a Switch from List of Switches to Be Checked        .
IF_SFW_CONFLICT_SWITCH_CHECKER I REMOVE_SWITCHES               Deletes a List of Switches                                  .
IF_SFW_UPGRADE                 I CHANGE_BF                     Switch off Business Functions Again                         .
IF_SF_PREVIEW_PPF              I GET_PREVIEW_DATA              Delivers the Data for the Preview (OTF Table)               .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I CHECK_VALIDITY                Checks the SB Entry                                         .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I GET_BO_CREATING_OBJECT        Returns Pointer for Generating the SB Entry                 .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I GET_BUFFER_OBJECT             Returns the SB Entry                                        .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I GET_BUFFER_OBJECT_KEY         Returns Key of SB Entry                                     .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I GET_VALIDITY_STRATEGY         Returns Pointer for Validity Check                          .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I SET_BO_CREATING_OBJECT        Sets Pointer for Generating SB Entry                        .
IF_SHARED_BUFFER_ITEM_CK       I SET_VALIDITY_STRATEGY         Sets Pointer for Validity Check                             .
IF_SHM_BUILD_INSTANCE          I BUILD                         Area Constructor                                            .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I DELETE_TRACE_TABLE            Deletes All Trace Entries of a Trace Variant                .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I DISPLAY_TRACE                 Display the Trace Entries for a Trace Variant               .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I GET_TRACE_COUNT               Returns the Number of the Entries for a Trace Variant       .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I GET_TRACE_TABLE               Returns All Trace Entries for a Trace Variant               .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I TRCX_CONSTRUCTOR              (obsolete)                                                  .
IF_SHM_TRACE                   I TRIN_CONSTRUCTOR              (obsolete)                                                  .
IF_SIC_ACCESS_DATA_MODEL       I GET_APPL_OBJECT_TYPE          Get object  type and subtype of the application object      .
IF_SIC_ACCESS_DATA_MODEL       I GET_NODE_FIELDS               Get the fields for a node                                   .
IF_SIC_ACCESS_DATA_MODEL       I GET_NODE_STRUCTURE            Get the node structure                                      .
IF_SIC_CONNECTOR               I GET_APPLICATION               Returns the application of the connector                    .
IF_SIC_CONNECTOR               I GET_DATA_MODEL_ACCESS_IF      Returns a reference to the data model access interface      .
IF_SIC_CONNECTOR               I GET_OWNER                     Returns the owner of the connector (domain SIC_OWNER)       .
IF_SIC_CONNECTOR               I GET_READ_DATA_IF              Returns a reference to the read data interface              .
IF_SIC_FM_FIELD_COMPARATOR     I COMPARE_FIELDS                Compare two fields                                          .
IF_SIC_FM_OBJ_MATCH_ANALYZER   I IS_DEFINITE_MATCH             Check on a semantic level if the two objects match definitly.
IF_SIC_FM_OBJ_MATCH_ANALYZER   I IS_NO_MATCH                   Check on a semantic level if the two objects do not match   .
IF_SIC_FM_OBJ_MATCH_ANALYZER   I IS_POTENTIAL_MATCH            Check on a semantic level if the two objs match potentially .
IF_SIC_INDEX_BUILDER           I INDEX                         Indexing                                                    .
IF_SIC_INDEX_SEARCH_ENGINE     I GET_ENGINE                    Get the used engine                                         .
IF_SIC_LOGGING                 I ADD_MESSAGE                   Add a new message to the message log                        .
IF_SIC_LOGGING                 I ADD_SYSTEM_MESSAGE            Add a new system message to the message log                 .
IF_SIC_LOGGING                 I GET_MESSAGE_LOG               Returns the message log                                     .
IF_SIC_MULTI_CNT_SERVICE       I EXECUTE                       Starts the execution of the service                         .
IF_SIC_NORM_BASIC_RULE         I NORMALIZE                     Execute Basic Rule                                          .
IF_SIC_NORM_BASIC_RULE         I SET_RULE                      Set Basic Rule                                              .
IF_SIC_NORM_BASIC_RULE_CONFIG  I CHECK_MULT_BASIC_RULE_TYPES   Check, if class supports multiple basic rule Types          .
IF_SIC_NORM_BASIC_RULE_CONFIG  I GET_BASIC_RULES               Get Basic Rules                                             .
IF_SIC_NORM_BASIC_RULE_CONFIG  I GET_MAINTENANCE_OBJECT        Get Transactions for the Customizing                        .
IF_SIC_NORM_CONDITION          I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Condition                                          .
IF_SIC_NORM_CONDITION          I SET_CONDITION                 Set Condition                                               .
IF_SIC_NORM_CONDITION_CONFIG   I CHECK_MULT_CONDITION_TYPES    Check if Class supports multipe condition types             .
IF_SIC_NORM_CONDITION_CONFIG   I GET_CONDITIONS                Get Conditions                                              .
IF_SIC_NORM_CONDITION_CONFIG   I GET_MAINTENANCE_OBJECT        Get Transactions for the Customizing                        .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_DATA_QUALITY              Returns the data quality for all object nodes in the group  .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_DATA_QUALITY_FOR_OBJ_NODE Returns the data quality for the specified object node      .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_GROUP_ID                  Returns the group ID                                        .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_OBJECTS                   Returns the objects contained in the group                  .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_REFERENCE_OBJECT          Returns the Reference object if it exists                   .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I GET_SIMILARITY_SCORES         Returns the similarity score for object pairs in the group  .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I SET_DATA_QUALITY              Sets the data quality for all object nodes in the group     .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_GROUP            I SET_SIMILARITY_SCORES         Sets the similarity score for object pairs in the group     .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I ADD_NORMALIZED_DATA           Adds the normalized data                                    .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_APPLICATION               Returns the application of the node                         .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_APPL_OBJECT_TYPE          Returns the unique identifier (application and object type) .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_CHILD_NODES               Returns the subordinate nodes                               .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_DATA_QUALITY              Returns the data quality of the object node                 .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_NODE_NAME                 Returns the name of the node                                .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_NORMALIZED_DATA           Returns the object node data and the normalized data        .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_NORMALIZE_SERVICE_PROFILE Returns the service profile used for normalization          .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_OBJECT_DATA               Returns the object node data                                .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_OBJECT_PRIMARY_ID         Returns the primary ID of the node                          .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_OBJECT_SECONDARY_ID       Returns the secondary ID of the node                        .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_OBJECT_SUBTYPE            Returns the object subtype of the node                      .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Returns the object type of the node                         .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I GET_PARENT_NODES              Returns the superior nodes                                  .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I REMOVE_NORMALIZED_DATA        Removes the normalized data from the object node            .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I SET_NORMALIZED_DATA           Sets the object node data and the normalized data           .
IF_SIC_OBJECT_NODE             I SET_NORMALIZE_SERVICE_PROFILE Sets the service profile that was used for normalization    .
IF_SIC_SEARCH_BUILDER          I SEARCH                        Search                                                      .
IF_SIC_SEARCH_RESULT           I GET_SEARCH_OBJECT             Returns the search object                                   .
IF_SIC_SEARCH_RESULT           I GET_SEARCH_RESULT_OBJECTS     Returns the objects contained in search result plus score   .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I ADD_SERVICE_PROFILE           Add a new Service profile                                   .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Check consistency of the specified Service profile          .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I CREATE_FIELD_PROVIDER_INSTANCECreate field provider instance                              .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I GET_CONTAINER_CONTENT_TYPES   Returns the list of container content types for the service .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I GET_FIELD_LIST                Returns the list of fields for the specified service profile.
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I GET_SERVICE_PROFILES          Returns the list of service profiles                        .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I MAINTAIN_SERVICE_PROFILE      Maintain the specified Service profile                      .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I SERVICE_PROFILE_EXIST         Existence check for the specified service profile           .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I SET_FIELD_PROVIDER_INSTANCE   Set the field provider instance                             .
IF_SIC_SERVICE_CONFIGURATION   I SET_SERVICE_PROFILE           Set the specified service profile                           .
IF_SIC_SINGLE_CNT_SERVICE      I EXECUTE                       Starts the execution of the service                         .
IF_SIGNATURE_DS_POC            I READ_SIGNATURE                Reads Signatures in Buffer                                  .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I CREATE_CHILD                  Create new Child                                            .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_CHILD                     Returns the Child with Index "N"                            .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_CHILD_BY_KEY              Returns the Child with Key "Key"                            .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_CHILD_COUNT               Returns the Number of Children                              .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_KEY                       Returns the Key of the Node                                 .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_NAME                      Returns the Name of the Node                                .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I GET_VALUE                     Reading a Value                                             .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I IS_EMPTY                      Is the PropTree empty?                                      .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I IS_VALUE                      Does the Value with Name exist?                             .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I REMOVE_CHILD                  Delete Child                                                .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I REMOVE_CHILD_BY_KEY           Delete Child with Key "Key"                                 .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I REMOVE_VALUE                  Remove Value                                                .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE              I SET_VALUE                     Sets Value                                                  .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE_LISTENER     I NODE_INSERTED                 Node Inserted                                               .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE_LISTENER     I NODE_REMOVED                  Node Deleted                                                .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE_LISTENER     I VALUE_MODIFIED                Value Modified                                              .
IF_SIMPLEPROPTREE_XML          I SAVE                          Serialization by XML                                        .
IF_SIMPLE_COMMAND_MM           I EXECUTE                       Execute (w/o Parameters)                                    .
IF_SKWF_AUTHORITY_CHECK        I APPL_AUTHORITY_CHECK          Check Authorizations for Application                        .
IF_SKWF_AUTHORITY_CHECK        I AUTHORITY_CHECK               Check Authorizations for IOs                                .
IF_SKWF_AUTHORITY_CHECK        I IOS_DELETED                   IOs Have Been Deleted                                       .
IF_SKWF_AUTHORITY_CHECK        I IOS_TRANSPORT                 IOs Should Be Transported                                   .
IF_SKWF_CACHE_INVALIDATION     I INVALIDATE                    Invalidate Cache                                            .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_CTX_SELECTOR   I ATTR_SELECTORS_GET            Get Selectors for an Attribute                              .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I DELETE                        Delete Packet                                               .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I FIND_BY_QUERY                 Find Package by Query (Only for Transient Packages)         .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IOS_ATTACH                    Insert IOs into Package                                     .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IOS_DETACH                    Delete IOs from Package                                     .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IOS_FIND_BY_QUERY             Find IOs in Package by External Properties                  .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IOS_GET                       Get IOs from Package                                        .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IOS_PROPERTIES_SET            Set External IO Properties                                  .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IO_PROPERTIES_DELETE          Delete External IO Properties                               .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IO_PROPERTIES_GET             Get External IO Properties                                  .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I IO_PROPERTIES_SET             Set External IO Properties                                  .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I ORDER_TYPE_SET                Set Classification Type                                     .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I PROPERTIES_DELETE             Delete Package Properties (Only with Transient Packages)    .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I PROPERTIES_GET                Get Package Properties                                      .
IF_SKWF_DYNAMIC_PACKAGE        I PROPERTIES_SET                Set Package Properties (Only with Transient Packages)       .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_CREATE_POST               Create Context (POST)                                       .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_CREATE_PRE                Create Context (PRE)                                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_DELETE_POST               Delete Context (POST)                                       .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_DELETE_PRE                Delete Context (PRE)                                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_SET_POST                  Set/Change Context Entries (Post)                           .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I CTX_SET_PRE                   Set/Change Context Entries (PRE)                            .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_ATTACH_POST        Create Info Objects in a Directory (POST)                   .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_ATTACH_PRE         Create Info Objects in a Directory (PRE)                    .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_DETACH_POST        Delete Info Objects from a Directory (POST)                 .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_DETACH_PRE         Delete Info Objects from a Directory (PRE)                  .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_LINK_POST          Link Info Objects with a Directory (POST)                   .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_LINK_PRE           Link Objects with a Directory (PRE)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_ORDER_POST         Assign Links and Attachments Manually (POST)                .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_ORDER_PRE          Assign Links and Attachments Manually (PRE)                 .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_UNLINK_POST        Delete Link with Info Objects (POST)                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I FOLDER_IOS_UNLINK_PRE         Delete Link with Info Objects (PRE)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_DELETE_POST               Delete Info Objects and/or Relations (POST)                 .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_DELETE_PRE                Delete Info Objects and/or Relations (PRE)                  .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_PROPERTIES_DELETE_POST    Delete Properties of Info Objects (POST)                    .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_PROPERTIES_DELETE_PRE     Delete Properties of Info Objects (PRE)                     .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_PROPERTIES_SET_POST       Set Properties of Info Objects (POST)                       .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IOS_PROPERTIES_SET_PRE        Set Properties of Info Objects (PRE)                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IO_COPY_POST                  Copy Info Object (POST)                                     .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I IO_COPY_PRE                   Copy Info Object (PRE)                                      .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIOS_PHIOS_GET_POST          Determine PHIOS to LOIOs with Context Resolution (POST)     .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIOS_PHIOS_GET_PRE           Determine PHIOS to LOIOS with Context Resolution (PRE)      .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_CREATE_AS_COPY_POST      Create a Logical Document as Copy of Another (POST)         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_CREATE_AS_COPY_PRE       Create a Logical Document as a Copy of Another (PRE)        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_CREATE_POST              Create a Logical Info Object (POST)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_CREATE_PRE               Create a Logical Info Object (PRE)                          .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_WITH_PHIO_CREATE_POST    Create a Logical and Physical Info Object (POST)            .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I LOIO_WITH_PHIO_CREATE_PRE     Create a Logical and Physical Info Object (PRE)             .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_CHECKOUT_CANCEL_POST    End Reservation of Physical Info Objects (POST)             .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_CHECKOUT_CANCEL_PRE     End Reservation of Physical Info Objects (PRE)              .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_CHECKOUT_POST           Check Out Physical Documents (POST)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_CHECKOUT_PRE            Check Out Physical Documents (PRE)                          .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_FILE_PROPERTIES_GET_POSTRead Admin Data of Phio Files (POST)                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_FILE_PROPERTIES_GET_PRE Read Admin Data of Phio Files (PRE)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_RESERVATION_CANCEL_POST Cancel Reservation of Physical Info Objects (POST)          .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_RESERVATION_CANCEL_PRE  Cancel Reservation of Physical Info Objects (PRE)           .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_RESERVE_POST            Reserve Physical Info Objects (POST)                        .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIOS_RESERVE_PRE             Reserve Physical Info Objects (PRE)                         .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CONTENT_ACCESS_GET_POST  Get Content Information for PHIO (POST)                     .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CONTENT_ACCESS_GET_PRE   Get Content Information for Phio (PRE)                      .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CONTENT_URL_GET_POST     Gets URL to Read a Physical Document (RFC Capable) (POST)   .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CONTENT_URL_GET_PRE      Gets URL to Read a Physical Document (RFC Capable) (PRE)    .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_AS_COPY_POST      Create a Physical IO as a Copy of Another (POST)            .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_AS_COPY_PRE       Create a Physical IO as a Copy of Another (PRE)             .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_NEW_VERSION_POST  Create a New Version of a Physical Document (POST)          .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_NEW_VERSION_PRE   Create a New Version of a Physical Document (PRE)           .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_POST              Create a New Empty Physical Info Object (POST)              .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_CREATE_PRE               Create a New Empty Physical Info Object (PRE)               .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_LOAD_CONTENT_POST        Load Content of Physical Info Object to Intern. Table (POST).
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_LOAD_CONTENT_PRE         Load Content of Physical Object to Intern. Table (PRE)      .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STATE_CONTENTLESS_POST   Declare Physical Document as Content Free (POST)            .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STATE_CONTENTLESS_PRE    Declare Physical Document as Content Free (PRE)             .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_AS_UPDATE_POST     Store Internal Table as New Version of Physical Doc (POST)  .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_AS_UPDATE_PRE      Store Internal Table as New Version of Physical Doc (PRE)   .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_CONTENT_POST       Store Content of Physical Object from Internal Table (POST) .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_CONTENT_PRE        Store Content of Physical Object from Internal Table (PRE)  .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_NEW_CONTENT_POST   Check in Phio as Template Copy (Part 2) (Post)              .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_NEW_CONTENT_PRE    Check in Phio as Template Copy (Part 2) (PRE)               .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_NEW_VERSION_POST   Store Internal Table as New Version of Physical Obj. (POST) .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I PHIO_STORE_NEW_VERSION_PRE    Store Internal Table as New Version of Physical Obj. (PRE)  .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I RELA_CREATE_POST              Create a Relation Between two Info Objects (POST)           .
IF_SKWF_EVENT_HANDLER          I RELA_CREATE_PRE               Create a Relation Between two Info Objects (PRE)            .
IF_SKWS_GUARD                  I CHECK                         Checks an Authorization                                     .
IF_SMIGR_DDL                   I GET_DDSTORAGE                 Gets DDSTORAGE Entries for Non-Standard SAP Objects         .
IF_SMTP_CLIENT                 I GET_LAST_ERROR                Last Error Message                                          .
IF_SMTP_CLIENT                 I SEND                          SMTP connection setup and dispatch of data                  .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I DISPLAY                       Displays "smpt-plugin-xstring" in Popup                     .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_EMAIL                     Returns E-mail in RFC822/MIME Format                        .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_EMAILDOMAIN               Returns E-Mail Domain of Sending SMTP Host                  .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_MESSAGE_PROBS             Returns Message Characteristics                             .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_ORIGINATOR                Returns Sender in SMTP Address Format                       .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_RECIPIENTS                Returns Sender and Status in Table                          .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I GET_STATUS                    Returns General Status Code                                 .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I MAP_ESMTP_RETURNCODE          Determines SAP Status Code from ESMTP Status Code           .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I MAP_SX_RETURNCODE             Determines ESMTP Status Code from SAP Status Code           .
IF_SMTP_ENTITY                 I SET_SERVER_PROPS              Sets Characteristics to Sent Mail Server                    .
IF_SMTP_EXTENSION              I HANDLE_REQUEST                Called by infrastructure for each incoming HTTP request     .
IF_SMTP_REQUEST                I PARSE                         Decoded received "smtp-plugin-string"                       .
IF_SMTP_REQUEST                I SERIALIZE                     Returns "smtp-plugin-string", SMTP plugin to be forwarded   .
IF_SMTP_RESPONSE               I PARSE                         Decoded "smtp-plugin-string", filled from SMTP plugin       .
IF_SMTP_RESPONSE               I SERIALIZE                     Coded "smtp-plugin-string", read from SMTP plugin           .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I GET_CHILDREN                  Get Children of Node                                        .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I GET_MAX_NODE_NUMBER           Get Highest Folder Number                                   .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I GET_NODES                     Get Node                                                    .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I GET_NODE_TEXT                 Get Text for Node                                           .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I SAVE                          Save Entries                                                .
IF_SMYO_MY_OBJECTS_MODEL       I SET_MAX_NODE_NUMBER           Set Highest Folder Number                                   .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I GET_APPLICATION_DATA          SNI Initialization: Buttons, Dropdown Listbox               .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I GET_SEARCH_ITEMS              Contents of Dropdown Listbox for the Search                 .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I HANDLE_EVENT                  Back-End Events                                             .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I INIT                          SNI Initialization                                          .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I IS_DIRTY                      Read Data Again?                                            .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I QUERY                         Find                                                        .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I READ                          Read Tree Areas                                             .
IF_SNI_TREE                    I READ_CHILDREN                 Read Child Nodes                                            .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I EXECUTE_PROCESSING            Execution of a Request                                      .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I GET_PROTOCOLS                 Request the SOAP Protocols                                  .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I GET_PROTOCOL_BY_NAME          Query SOAP Protocol by Name (URI)                           .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I GET_REQUEST_MESSAGE           Request the Request Message                                 .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I GET_RESPONSE_MESSAGE          Request the Response Message                                .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I GET_TRANSPORT_BINDING         Query Transport Binding                                     .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_CS         I INIT                          Initialization of Application with Configuration (Client)   .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_DT         I CHECK_CONFIGURATION           Validity Check of a Feature Configuration                   .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_DT         I GET_CODE_GENERATOR            Gets Generator for STs and Proxy Code                       .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_DT         I GET_FEATURES                  Request All Design Features of SOAP Application             .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_DT         I GET_PROFILES                  Request Design Configuration Profiles for SOAP Application  .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_DT         I GET_RUNTIME_FEATURES          Request All Runtime Features for SOAP Application           .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I EXEC_PROCESSING               Execute Application Logic (Server-Side)                     .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_PROTOCOLS                 Requesting all SOAP Protocols of the Application            .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_PROTOCOL_BY_NAME          Query Specific SOAP Protocol                                .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_REQUEST_MESSAGE           Request the Request Message                                 .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_RESPONSE_MESSAGE          Request the Response Message                                .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_ROLES                     Request the SOAP Role(s)                                    .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I GET_TRANSPORT_BINDING         Request Transport Bindings of the Application               .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I INIT                          Initialize Application with Configuration                   .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I INIT_PROCESSING               Initialization for Request Processing                       .
IF_SOAP_APPLICATION_RT         I INIT_WS                       Initialize Application with WS Key (Server Only)            .
IF_SOAP_ATTACHMENT_MESSAGE     I ADD_ATTACHMENT_PART           Add mime parts to attachment bag                            .
IF_SOAP_ATTACHMENT_MESSAGE     I ADD_BODY_PART                 Add xml elements to soap body                               .
IF_SOAP_ATTACHMENT_MESSAGE     I ADD_HEADER_PART               Add xml elements to soap header                             .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURABLE           I GET_FEATURE_PROPERTY          Read Value of a Feature Property                            .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURABLE           I GET_SUPPORTED_FEATURE_URIS    Determine Features Supported by Configurable Object         .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURABLE           I SET_FEATURE_PROPERTY          Set Value of a Feature Property                             .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I ADD_DESIGNTIME_FEATURES       Gets SOAP Features                                          .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I ADD_RUNTIME_FEATURES          Gets SOAP Features                                          .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I GET_DESIGNTIME_FEATURES       Gets SOAP Features                                          .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I GET_RUNTIME_FEATURES          Gets SOAP Features                                          .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I QUERY_DT_FEATURES             Get All Features that Match Feature URI                     .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I QUERY_DT_VALUES               Get Values for Given Feature/Property                       .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I QUERY_RT_FEATURES             Get All Features that Match Feature URI                     .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE              I QUERY_RT_VALUES               Get Values for Given Feature/Property                       .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE_SERVICE      I GET_OPERATIONS                Gets List of Operations                                     .
IF_SOAP_CONFIGURE_SERVICE      I GET_OPERATION_CONFIGURATION   Gets List of Operation-Specific Configurations              .
IF_SOAP_CONFIG_PROFILE         I GET_CONFIGURATION             Configuration Details of Profile                            .
IF_SOAP_CONFIG_PROFILE         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description of Configuration Profile                        .
IF_SOAP_CONFIG_PROFILE         I GET_NAME                      Name of Configuration Profile                               .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I ADD_REASON                    Add Description for Fault Reason                            .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I ADD_SUBCODE                   Add Code to Subcodes                                        .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I RAISE_FAULT                   Trigger Internal Exception to Send Fault                    .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I SET_CODE_BY_ID                Set Fault Code and Fault Name from Fault ID                 .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I SET_CODE_BY_NAME              Set Fault Code and Fault Name from Fault Name               .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I SET_NODENAME                  Who is responsible for this fault?                          .
IF_SOAP_FAULT                  I SET_ROLE                      Set Current Role of Current User                            .
IF_SOAP_FEATURE                I CLONE                         Generate Copy                                               .
IF_SOAP_FEATURE                I GET_PROPERTIES                Request All Properties of this Feature                      .
IF_SOAP_FEATURE                I GET_PROPERTY                  Search for Property by Name                                 .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I DISABLE_SESSION               Set Stateless Communication                                 .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I ENABLE_SESSION                Set Stateful Communication                                  .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I GET_CLIENT                    Access to Current HTTP Client Control Block                 .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I GET_SERVER                    Access to Current HTTP Server Control Block                 .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_CLIENT                    Set Current HTTP Client Control Block                       .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_CLIENT_BY_DESTINATION     Generate HTTP Client Control Block Using SM59 Destination   .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_CLIENT_BY_URL             Generate HTTP Client Control Block Using URL                .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_DESTINATION_URL_PATH      Set Path Suffix for Destination Generated with HTTP Client  .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_SERVER                    Set Current HTTP Server Control Block                       .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_SESSION_METHOD            Set Mechanism for Stateful Communication                    .
IF_SOAP_HTTP_TRANSPORT_BINDING I SET_SOAP_ACTION               Set SOAP Action Header Field                                .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I ADD_ATTACHMENT_PART           Add mime elements to the message                            .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I ADD_BODY_FAULT                Get and Set Fault Element for SOAP Body                     .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I ADD_BODY_PART                 Add xml elements to soap body                               .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I ADD_FAULT_PART                Add XML Element to List of Expected Application Faults      .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I ADD_HEADER_PART               Add xml elements to soap header                             .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I GET_ATTACHMENT_PART           Get MIME Attachment                                         .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE                I NUM_ATTACHMENT_PARTS          Returns Number of Attachments                               .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I DESERIALIZE_BODY              Deserialize SOAP Header of Part                             .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I DESERIALIZE_HEADER            Deserialize SOAP Header of Part                             .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I GET_PART_ID                   Get the ID that should be unique for all parts              .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I INIT_FOR_DESERIALIZE          Initialize Before Deserialization                           .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I INIT_FOR_SERIALIZE            Initialize Before Serialization                             .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I SERIALIZE                     Serialize this part                                         .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I SET_PART_ID                   Set the ID that should be unique for all parts              .
IF_SOAP_MESSAGE_PART           I _DESERIALIZE                  Deserialize this part                                       .
IF_SOAP_MSGID_PROTOCOL         I GET_MESSAGE_ID                Get Message ID                                              .
IF_SOAP_MSGID_PROTOCOL         I GET_MESSAGE_ID_AS_STRUCT      Get Message ID                                              .
IF_SOAP_PROPERTY               I CLONE                         Create Copy of Instance                                     .
IF_SOAP_PROPERTY               I GET_ALLOWED_VALUES            Request Allowed Values of the Property (Value Range)        .
IF_SOAP_PROPERTY               I GET_CONFIGURED_VALUES         Request Current Values of Property                          .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I CLEANUP_ON_FAULT              After Error, Instead of POST_PROCESS                        .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I FAULT_PROCESS                 Process SOAP Fault in SOAP Client                           .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I GET_FEATURES                  Gets Characteristics of SOAP Protocol                       .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I GET_SUPPORTED_HEADER_ELEMENTS Gets SOAP Header Elements Handled by Protocol               .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I POST_PROCESS                  Process Header After Request                                .
IF_SOAP_PROTOCOL               I PRE_PROCESS                   Process Header Before Request                               .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_REGISTRY_NAME             Get Name (URI) of Registry Implementation                   .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_SOAP_APPLICATION_CLASS    Read Class Name for a Specified SOAP Application            .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WSDL                      Get WSDL Description of Web Service                         .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WSD_NAME                  Get WSD Name for WS Key                                     .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WS_CONFIGURATION          Read Configuration for a Web Service                        .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WS_KEY                    Get WS Key for Specified Transport Key                      .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WS_OPERATION_NAMES        Get Operation name for WS Key                               .
IF_SOAP_REGISTRY               I GET_WS_OP_CONFIGURATION       Get Configuration for Web Service Operation                 .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I GET_LOGLEVEL                  Get Logging Level                                           .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I GET_MONLEVEL                  Get Monitoring Level                                        .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I GET_TRACELEVEL                Get Trace Level                                             .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I SET_LOGLEVEL                  Set Logging Level                                           .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I SET_MONLEVEL                  Set Monitoring Level                                        .
IF_SOAP_RUNTIME_PROTOCOL       I SET_TRACELEVEL                Set Trace Level                                             .
IF_SOAP_SERIALIZE_CONTEXT      I GET_STREAM                    Set Message Stream                                          .
IF_SOAP_SERIALIZE_CONTEXT      I SET_STREAM                    Set Message Stream                                          .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL       I DISABLE_SESSION               Deactivate Session-Oriented Communication                   .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL       I ENABLE_SESSION                Activate Session-Oriented Communication                     .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL       I GET_SESSION_METHOD            Get Session Mechanism                                       .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL       I GET_SESSION_MODE              Get Session Mode                                            .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL_RT    I DISABLE_SESSION               Deactivate Session-Oriented Communication                   .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL_RT    I ENABLE_SESSION                Activate Session-Oriented Communication                     .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL_RT    I GET_SESSION_METHOD            Get Session Mechanism                                       .
IF_SOAP_SESSION_PROTOCOL_RT    I GET_SESSION_MODE              Get Session Mode                                            .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I GET_URI                       Read Transport Binding URI                                  .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I PREPARE_RESPONSE_FOR_FAULT    Handle Response Message as SOAP Fault                       .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I PROCESS_BODY                  Receives and Deserializes Message Body                      .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I PROCESS_HEADER                Receives and Deserializes Message Header                    .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I RECEIVE                       Receive and Deserialize Message                             .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I REQUEST                       Access to Request Message                                   .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I RESPONSE                      Access to Response Message                                  .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I SEND                          Serialize and Send Message                                  .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_BINDING      I SET_NODE_TYPE                 Configure Binding for Node Type                             .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I GET_REQUEST_ID                Get Call Type                                               .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I GET_TRANSPORT_ID              Get ID of Basic Transport Mechanism                         .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I GET_TRANSPORT_KEY             Read the Transport-Specific Key                             .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I INIT                          Create Initial State                                        .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I SET_REQUEST_ID                Get Call Type                                               .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I SET_TRANSPORT_ID              Set ID of Basic Transport Mechanism                         .
IF_SOAP_TRANSPORT_CONTEXT      I SET_TRANSPORT_KEY             Set the Transport-Specific Key                              .
IF_SORTABLE_TRANSACTION_TRG    I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Gets Attributes of the Business Transaction                 .
IF_SORTED_LIST_COMPARATOR      I COMPARE_ENTRIES               Compares Current Entries                                    .
IF_SORTED_LIST_COMP_LISTENER   I WHEN_IN_BOTH_LISTS            Called if Current Entry Exists in Both Lists                .
IF_SORTED_LIST_COMP_LISTENER   I WHEN_ONLY_IN_LIST1            Called if Current Entry Exists in List 1 Only               .
IF_SORTED_LIST_COMP_LISTENER   I WHEN_ONLY_IN_LIST2            Called if Current Entry Exists in List 2 Only               .
IF_SORTED_LIST_CURSOR          I IS_VALID                      Determines Whether Cursor Selects a Valid Entry             .
IF_SORTED_LIST_CURSOR          I NEXT                          Gets Next Entry of Sorted List                              .
IF_SOTR_EDITOR                 I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Editor                                          .
IF_SOTR_EDITOR                 I UPDATE                        Initializes Editor with New Concept                         .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I DO_FUNCTIONS                  Execute Additional Function                                 .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I FREE                          Resource Release                                            .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I GET_FUNCTIONS                 Find Additional Functions That Tool Offers                  .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I INITIALIZE                    Initializes the Tool                                        .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I REFRESH                       Refreshes the Content                                       .
IF_SOTR_WORKLIST_TOOLS         I UPDATE_CONTENT                Updates the Content                                         .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I ADDR_DATA_GET                 Get Address Data                                            .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I ADDR_LOC_DETERMINE            Determine Addresses for Search List                         .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I DELETE_SUPPL_CHECK            Check Vendor Before Deletion                                .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I PRESELECT_SUPPLIER            Preselect Supplier Prior to Evaluation                      .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I REF_LOC_ADDR_DESCR            Request Address Description of Reference Location           .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I SUPPLIER_DETERMINE            Determine Supplier                                          .
IF_SOURCE_DETERMINATION        I SUPPLIER_EVALUATE             Interface for External Vendor Evaluation                    .
IF_SPAK_OBJECT_PROPAGATOR      I DISPLAY                       Displays Screen Elements                                    .
IF_SPAK_OBJECT_PROPAGATOR      I SAVE                          Saves the Changes                                           .
IF_SPAK_OBJECT_PROPAGATOR      I TERMINATE                     End Tool                                                    .
IF_SPAK_USE_ACCESS_GATEKEEPER  I DISPLAY                       Displays the tool                                           .
IF_SPAK_USE_ACCESS_GATEKEEPER  I SAVE                          Saves the Changes                                           .
IF_SPAK_USE_ACCESS_GATEKEEPER  I TERMINATE                     Terminates Tool                                             .
IF_SPA_ESI_OBJECT_PROXY        I GET_BO_NAME                   Gets Name of ESI Business Object                            .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I ACTIVATE                      Activates Monitoring                                        .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivates Monitoring                                      .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_ALERT_SHORT               Gets Alert Messages of CCMS in Short Form                   .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_LAST_START                Last Start Time (UTC) of Monitoring                         .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_LAST_STARTER              Name of person who started monitoring process               .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_LAST_STOP                 Last Stop Time (UTC) of Monitoring                          .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_LAST_STOPPER              Name of person who stopped monitoring process               .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_LAST_UPDATE               Last change to process store for this process               .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_PROCESS_VARIANT           Gets Process Variant                                        .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I GET_USER_NAME                 Conversion SY-UNAME -" Address Name                         .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I IS_ACTIVE                     True if process is actively monitored                       .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I IS_ANY_PROCESS_ACTIVE         Active Process Monitoring (Cross-Client)                    .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I IS_RELEASED                   True, if Process Released                                   .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I IS_STEP_ACTIVE                True, if Step Monitored Actively                            .
IF_SPI_ADMIN                   I SET_PROCESS_VARIANT           Set New Process Variant (space = reset)                     .
IF_SPI_AS_EXIT                 I GET_AS_PROCESS_INST           Returns Filter-Dependent Reference on if_spi_process_path   .
IF_SPI_AS_EXIT                 I GET_PAYLOAD_FLDNAMES          Returns Names of Payload Fields Being Loaded                .
IF_SPI_AS_EXIT                 I SAVE_PROCESS_INST             Other Actions for New and Changed Instances                 .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I CALL_DISPLAY_TOOL             Go to External Display                                      .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I COUNT_INSTANCES               Returns Number of Process Instance Objects of an Attribute  .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_DETAIL                    Detail Data for an Attribute                                .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_DISPLAY_TOOL_URL          URL for calling display tool for attribute                  .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_INSTANCES                 Returns Process Instance Objects for an Attribute           .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_TYPE                      Data Type of Attribute Value (String, Number, or Date)      .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_VALUE                     Attribute Value                                             .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description of Attribute                                    .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I GET_FILTER_VALUES             Filter Values for Restricting the Process Instance Amount   .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I GET_ICON_NAME                 SAP Icon of an Attribute                                    .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I GET_ID                        ID of this Attribute                                        .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I GET_TYPE                      Data Type of Attribute Value (String, Number, or Date)      .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I HAS_DETAIL                    Can Return Detail Data for Attribute Values                 .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I HAS_DISPLAYTOOL               Can Go To External Display Tool                             .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I HAS_INSTANCES                 Can Return Process Instances for the Attribute              .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION    I HAS_VALUE                     Can Return an Attribute Value                               .
IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE         I LOAD                          Load Attributes                                             .
IF_SPI_AUTHORIZATION_GROUP     I CREATE                        Creates New Authorization Group                             .
IF_SPI_AUTHORIZATION_GROUP     I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Description for Language                               .
IF_SPI_AUTHORIZATION_GROUP     I GET_INSTANCE                  Factory Method: Gets Instance for Existing Group            .
IF_SPI_AUTHORIZATION_GROUP     I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets Description for Language                               .
IF_SPI_CM_CHECK                I IS_CONSISTENT                 Consistency Check for a PMI Metadata Object                 .
IF_SPI_COMMON                  I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns an instance of IF_SPI_ATTRIBUTE for the ID          .
IF_SPI_COMMON                  I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Request attribute list                                      .
IF_SPI_COMMON                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Request description                                         .
IF_SPI_COMPARABLE              I EQUALS                        Check whether two objects are the same                      .
IF_SPI_CONFIGURATION_COMPONENT I GET_STEPS                     Gets Possible Steps Within Component                        .
IF_SPI_CONFIGURATION_STATIC    I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets Process Configuration Interface                        .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I GET_PROCESS_GUIDS             Get GUIDs of selected process instances                     .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I GET_PROCESS_INSTANCES         Get process instance objects                                .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I GET_RESTRICTIONS              Returns Filter Criteria                                     .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I RESET_RESTRICTIONS            Resets Filter Criteria                                      .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I SET_RESTRICTION               Set Filter Criteria                                         .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I SET_TIMEINT                   Set Time (=Process Start) as Criterium                      .
IF_SPI_INSTANCE_SEARCH         I SIMPLE_SET_RESTRICTIONS       Simplified Setting of Filter Criteria                       .
IF_SPI_ITERATOR                I HAS_NEXT                      Returns true if there are more elements                     .
IF_SPI_ITERATOR                I NEXT                          Returns reference to the next object                        .
IF_SPI_MESSAGE                 I RAISE_MESSAGE                 Issue message                                               .
IF_SPI_OPERATOR                I DESCRIBE_RELATED              delivers selection criteria for related record              .
IF_SPI_OPERATOR                I FIND_RELATED                  find processes related to a record                          .
IF_SPI_OPERATOR                I FIND_RELATED_RECORDS          Find Records Related to Process Instance                    .
IF_SPI_OPERATOR                I INIT                          initialize the operator                                     .
IF_SPI_OPERATOR                I RELATE                        check the relation between two records                      .
IF_SPI_OP_CHECK                I IS_SUPPORTED_COMPERAT         Checks whether the operator is supported                    .
IF_SPI_OP_CHECK                I IS_SUPPORTED_FLDNAM           Checks whether technical field is supported                 .
IF_SPI_OVERVIEW                I GET_AGGREGATED_DATA           Gets Cumulated Runtime Data                                 .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_ADMIN_INFO                Gets Administration Information for Process                 .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_INITIAL_STEPS             Gets Start Steps for Process                                .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_PROCESS_ID                Returns the process type (GUID)                             .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_STEPS                     Gets Steps for Process                                      .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_TIME_INT                  Gets Time Interval (Possibly Modified)                      .
IF_SPI_PROCESS                 I GET_TRANSITIONS               Gets Transitions for Process                                .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_AUTHORIZATION   I DELETE_AUTHORIZATION          Removes an Authorization Group from the Process             .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_AUTHORIZATION   I GET_ALL_AUTHORIZATIONS        Returns All Instances of Authorization Groups for Process   .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_AUTHORIZATION   I GET_AUTHORIZATION             Gets Instance of Authorization Group                        .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_AUTHORIZATION   I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets Instance for Process ID                                .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_AUTHORIZATION   I SET_AUTHORIZATION             Assigns Authorization Group to Process                      .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_CONFIGURATION   I GET_COMPONENT                 Gets Specified Component in Process                         .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_CONFIGURATION   I GET_PROCESS                   Gets Interface for Configured Process                       .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_CREATION_TIME             Process instance creation/change by assembler               .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_DURATION                  Process duration (in seconds), if still open: initial       .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_END_TIME                  End time (UTC), if not available: initial                   .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_PROCESS                   Gets Process for Process Instance                           .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_PROCESS_ID                Gets Process ID                                             .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_START_TIME                Start time (UTC)                                            .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_STEP_INSTANCES            Returns step instances                                      .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I GET_TRANSITION_INSTANCES      Gets Transition Instances                                   .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I IS_COMPLETE                   Is Process Complete?                                        .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_INST            I IS_FINISHED                   Has Process Ended?                                          .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I ADD_STEP                      Adds a step                                                 .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I BEFORE_SAVING                 Call Before Saving and Before Determining Header            .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I EXPAND                        Returns infosets for a process instance                     .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I GET_HEADER                    Returns instance header                                     .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I GET_RECORD                    Returns tracking record for step                            .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I IS_COMPLETE                   Is process complete?                                        .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I IS_FINISHED                   Is process finished?                                        .
IF_SPI_PROCESS_PATH            I REMOVE_DELETED                Remove Deleted Steps                                        .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Checks Consistency                                          .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I GET_RESTRICTIONS              Gets Filter Criteria                                        .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I PROPOSE_VALID_TIME_BOUNDARIES Gets Suitable Interval Limits                               .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I RESET_RESTRICTIONS            Gets Filter Criteria                                        .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I SET_RESTRICTIONS              Set Filter Criteria                                         .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I SET_TIMEINT                   Gets Criterion for Time Interval                            .
IF_SPI_SEARCH_FILTER           I SIMPLE_SET_RESTRICTION        Set Filter Criterion (Simple)                               .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_INSTANCE_ATTRIBUTES       Gets Attribute Definitions for Step Instances               .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_NAME                      Gets Step Name                                              .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_PREDECESSORS              Gets Predecessor of Step                                    .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_PROCESS                   Returns process that belongs to this step                   .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_STEP_ID                   Gets Step ID (GUID)                                         .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_SUCCESSORS                Gets Successor of Step                                      .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I GET_TRANSITIONS               Gets Inbound and Outbound Transition Links                  .
IF_SPI_STEP                    I IS_EVENT                      Event?                                                      .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_DESTINATION               Gets Original RFC Destination for Step                      .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_PREDECESSORS              Gets Predecessor for Step Instance                          .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_PROCESS_INSTANCE          Gets Process Instance for Step Instance                     .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_STEP                      Gets Step Definition                                        .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_STEP_ID                   Gets Step ID                                                .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_STEP_INST_GUID            Gets Step Instance ID                                       .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_SUCCESSORS                Gets Successor for Step Instance                            .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I GET_TRANSITION_INSTANCES      Transitions to or from Step                                 .
IF_SPI_STEP_INST               I IS_EVENT                      Event?                                                      .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_FILTER_CONDITIONS         Returns Conditions for Process Instance Search              .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTE         Returns Process Attribute Instance                          .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_PROCESS_ATTRIBUTES        Returns Instance-Independent Process Attributes             .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_PROCESS_INST_ATTRIBUTE    Returns Process Instance Attribute Instance                 .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_PROCESS_INST_ATTRIBUTES   Returns Instance-Independent Process Attributes             .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_RESTRICTIVE_ATTRIBUTES    Returns Possible Attributes for Restriction                 .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_STEP_ATTRIBUTE            Returns Process Step Attribute Instance                     .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_STEP_ATTRIBUTES           Returns Instance-Independent Step Attributes                .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_STEP_INST_ATTRIBUTE       Returns Process Step Instance Attribute Instance            .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_STEP_INST_ATTRIBUTES      Returns Instance-Independent Step Attributes                .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_TRANS_ATTRIBUTE           Returns Process Step Transition Attribute Instance          .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_TRANS_ATTRIBUTES          Returns Instance-Independent Transition Attributes          .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_TRANS_INST_ATTRIBUTE      Returns Process Step Transition Instance Attribute Instance .
IF_SPI_TOOL                    I GET_TRANS_INST_ATTRIBUTES     Returns Instance-Independent Transition Attributes          .
IF_SPI_TOOL_CONDENSE           I AGGREGATE                      Aggregation of Attributes of a Tool at Process Level       .
IF_SPI_TOOL_CONDENSE           I DELETE                        Deletion of Aggregated Attributes of a Tool                 .
IF_SPI_TOOL_CONDENSE           I REMOVE_INVALID_PROCESSES      Delete Non-Assigned Entries                                 .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I EXPAND                        Gets Expanded Display                                       .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I GET_AGENT                     Returns ID of agent and structure                           .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I GET_INSTAMP                   Returns incoming stamp in central repository                .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I GET_PAYLOAD                   Returns layload as table                                    .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I GET_VALUE                     Returns value for a payload                                 .
IF_SPI_TRACKING_RECORD         I IS_EQUAL                      Compares Two Tracking Records                               .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I GET_INSTANCE_ATTRIBUTES       Gets Attribute Description for Process Instances            .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I GET_PROCESS                   Returns the process that belongs to this transition         .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I GET_STEPS                     Gets Steps for Transition                                   .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I GET_TRANSITION_TYPE           Gets Type of Transition                                     .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I IS_SOURCE                     Checks whether step is source of transition                 .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION              I IS_TARGET                     Checks whether step is destination of the transition        .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION_INST         I GET_STEP_INSTANCES            Gets Step Instances for Transition Instance                 .
IF_SPI_TRANSITION_INST         I GET_TRANSITION                Gets Transition to Transition Instance                      .
IF_SPWSE_MAP_DIC_NAMES         I GET_APPL_DTELS_BY_PRX_DTELS   Application can adapt the appl. data element names          .
IF_SP_BOR                      I GET_BOR_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_SP_BOR                      I GET_BOR_ID_FROM_OBJECT        Finds BOR_ID from OBJECT_REFERENCE                          .
IF_SP_BOR                      I GET_SP_POID                   Gets SP POID from Current Paramaters                        .
IF_SP_BOR                      I UPDATE_OBJECT_REFERENCE       Creates New Object Reference from Changed BOR_ID            .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EE_TIME_EVAL      I GET_TIME_TYPE                 Time Type Depending on Org. Assignment of Day               .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I GET_BEGIN_OF_EDUCATION        Gets Start of Education/Training                            .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I GET_EMPLOYEE_DETAILS          Gets Additional Personal Data                               .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I GET_EXAMINATION_SCHEME        Gets Examination Scheme and Training Path                   .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I GET_RETRO_CALC_DATE           Gets the recalculation date (unbuffered)                    .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I GET_RETRO_CALC_LIMIT          Gets the Limit for a Person                                 .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I IS_STUDENT                    Is the Person a Student Nurse?                              .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I READ_SALDO                    Gets Balance for a Period                                   .
IF_SP_PS_TSN_EMPLOYEE          I SAVE_RETROCALC_DATE           Save Recalculation Date                                     .
IF_SRAPI_CONT_ACTION_70        I ACTIVATE                      Activate Container                                          .
IF_SRAPI_CONT_ACTION_70        I DELETE                        Delete Container                                            .
IF_SRAPI_CONT_ACTION_RENDER_70 I ACTIVATE                      Activates Container                                         .
IF_SRAPI_CONT_ACTION_RENDER_70 I DELETE                        Deletes Container                                           .
IF_SRAPI_QUERY_SERVICE         I GENERAL_QUERY                 Executes Query                                              .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I ADD_NAMESPACES_TO_SWCV        Add Namespaces for a SWCV                                   .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I CREATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Creates Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I DELETE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Deletes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I GET_NAMESPACES                Gets Namespaces for a SWCV (GUID)                           .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I GET_REPOSITORY_LEVEL          Returns Repository Release                                  .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I GET_REP_OBJECT                Gets a Repository Object for a Given Key                    .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I GET_REP_OBJECTS               Returns Repository Objects for Given Selection              .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I GET_SOFTWARE_COMP_VERSIONS    Gets All Software Component Versions of the Repository      .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I IMPORT_SOFTWARE_COMP_VERSION  Imports a SWCV into the Repository                          .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REPOSITORY    I UPDATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Changes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REP_INTERNAL  I GET_QUERY_SERVICE             Gets Query Service of Repository                            .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REP_INTERNAL  I GET_WRITE_SERVICE             Gets WriteService of Repository                             .
IF_SRAPI_SERVICE_REP_INTERNAL  I GET_WSDL_SERVICE              Gets WSDLService of Respository                             .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_REQ_RENDERER    I ADD_NAMESPACES_TO_SWCV        Adds Namespaces to SWCV                                     .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_REQ_RENDERER    I CREATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Creates Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_REQ_RENDERER    I DELETE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Deletes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_REQ_RENDERER    I IMPORT_SOFTWARE_COMP_VERSION  Import SWCV from SLD to Repository                          .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_REQ_RENDERER    I UPDATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Changes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_SERVICE         I ADD_NAMESPACES_TO_SWCV        Add Namespaces for a SWCV                                   .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_SERVICE         I CREATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Creates Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_SERVICE         I DELETE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Deletes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WRITE_SERVICE         I UPDATE_DATA_TYPE_ENHANCEMENT  Changes Data Type Enhancement in Repository                 .
IF_SRAPI_WSDL_OBJECT           I GET_WSDL                      Returns WSDL as String                                      .
IF_SRAPI_WSDL_SERVICE          I GET_WSDL                      Returns WSDL as String                                      .
IF_SREL_BROWSER                I DISPLAY                       Display Object                                              .
IF_SREL_BROWSER                I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Enter Required Attribute                                    .
IF_SREL_BROWSER                I MODIFY_FIELD_LIST             Modify Field List of Attribute                              .
IF_SREL_BROWSER_COMMANDS       I ADD_BUTTONS                   Add Push Button for ALV Toolbar                             .
IF_SREL_CTXMENU                I EXECUTE_COMMAND               Execute Menu Function                                       .
IF_SREL_CTXMENU                I SET_MENU                      Transfer Menu Entry                                         .
IF_SREL_LINKS                  I MODIFY_LINK_LIST              Modify Relationship List                                    .
IF_SRM                         I ADD_OBJECT_CLASS_ROLE         Add: Class Role for Object                                  .
IF_SRM                         I ADD_RELATED_OBJECT            Add: Buffer: Class Role -" Object Reference                 .
IF_SRM                         I DELETE_ALL_RELATED_OBJECTS    Delete: Buffer: All: Class Role -" Object Reference         .
IF_SRM                         I DELETE_RELATED_OBJECT         Delete: Buffer: Class Role -" Object Reference              .
IF_SRM                         I GET_EXCEPTION_TEXT            Get: Text From Error Class, Optional Previous Concatenated  .
IF_SRM                         I GET_MY_CLASS_REGISTRY         Get: Corresponding Class Registry Object                    .
IF_SRM                         I GET_MY_INTERFACES             Get: Returns all Intefaces of Class                         .
IF_SRM                         I GET_OBJECT_CLASS_ROLES        Get: Active Class Roles of Object                           .
IF_SRM                         I GET_REGISTERED_CLASS_ROLES    Get: List of Registered Class Roles for Object              .
IF_SRM                         I GET_RELATED_OBJECT            Get: Buffer: Class Role -"Object Reference                  .
IF_SRM                         I GET_ROOT                      Get: SRM Root Object                                        .
IF_SRM                         I GET_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY        Get: Interface Reference to SRM Object Factory              .
IF_SRM                         I GET_SRM_REGISTRY              Get: Interface Reference to SRM Registry                    .
IF_SRM                         I GET_SRM_SERVICE               Get: Interface Reference to SRM Service                     .
IF_SRM                         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Object Using SRM                          .
IF_SRM                         I IS_INTERFACE_AVAILABLE        Interface Implemented for Class?                            .
IF_SRM                         I IS_OBJECT_OF_CLASS_ROLE       Is the Object in the Class Role?                            .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I ADD_ACTIVITY                  Inserts Specific Activity                                   .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I ADD_ACTIVITY_LIST             Inserts Activity List                                       .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I ADD_SEPARATOR                 Inserts Separator                                           .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I ADD_STANDARD                  Inserts Standard Activity                                   .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I CHECK_ACTIVITY                Not Including Subobjects                                    .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I CHECK_ACTIVITY_RESOLVED       Including Subobjects                                        .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I GET_ACTIVITIES                Activity List of Object                                     .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I GET_ACTIVITIES_RESOLVED       Activities Including Subobjects                             .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I GET_DEFAULT                   Get: Default Activity                                       .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I GET_DEFAULT_CHANGING          Get: Default Activity (changing activity)                   .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I SET_DEFAULT                   Set: Default Activity                                       .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_LIST           I SET_DEFAULT_CHANGING          Set: Default Activity (changing activity)                   .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_MODIFIER       I MODIFY_INSTANCE               Modifies Instance Activities                                .
IF_SRM_ACTIVITY_MODIFIER       I MODIFY_MODEL                  Modifies Model Activities                                   .
IF_SRM_ALV                     I GET_ALV                       GET_ALV                                                     .
IF_SRM_ALV                     I SET_ENABLE                    Enable/Disable ALV                                          .
IF_SRM_AL_DOCVIEW_BSP          I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get Display Name                                            .
IF_SRM_AL_DOCVIEW_BSP          I GET_PROPERTIES                Get AL SP Information (Repository ID, MIME Type, BOR Type..).
IF_SRM_ARCHIVE_CONNECTION      I CHECK                         Connection Check                                            .
IF_SRM_ARCHIVE_CONNECTION      I CONNECT                       Load Data from the Archive in the Runtime Object            .
IF_SRM_ARCHIVE_QUERY           I BUILD_QUERY                   Defines Table with Selection Parameters for Archive Search  .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I CHECK_SPS_CLASSI_PARA_ID      Checks Element Type Classification Parameter ID             .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I CHECK_SPS_CLASSI_PARA_VALUE   Checks Element Type Classification Parameter Value          .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I CHECK_SPS_CLASSI_PARA_VALUE_IDChecks Element Type Classification Parameter Value ID       .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_AREA_PARA_DESCR           List of all Area Pararmeters Description                    .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_AREA_PARA_VALUE           List of all Area Parameter Values                           .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_AREA_POID_PARA_DESCR      Area POID Parameter Description                             .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_AREA_POID_PARA_VALUE      Area POID Parameter Values                                  .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get: Display Name                                           .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_ID                        Get: Area ID                                                .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_POID_DIRECTORY_INFO       Returns POID Directory Properties for Area                  .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_SPS_CLASSI_PARA_DESCR     List: Element Type AREA Classification PARA Descriptions    .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_SPS_CLASSI_PARA_VALUE     List: Element Type AREA Classification PARA Values          .
IF_SRM_AREA_REGISTRY           I GET_SP_REGISTRIES             Get: List of All SP Registrys for Area                      .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_GENERAL_DESCRIPTION       General Description Information                             .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_ID                        Get: Attribute ID                                           .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_INTEGER_DESCRIPTION       Integer-Specific Description Information                    .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_INTERFACE_DESCRIPTION     Interface-Specific Description Information                  .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_QUERY_DESCRIPTION         Query Description Information                               .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_RELATED_DESC              Gets Reference Fields                                       .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_STATE                     Returns Object Status                                       .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_STRING_DESCRIPTION        String-Specific Description Information                     .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_TABFIELD_DESCRIPTION      Table Field-Specific Description Information                .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_TYPE                      Gets Data Type (IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC="STRING, ...)         .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_VISUAL_DESCRIPTION        Visualization Description Information                       .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I GET_VIS_IN_LIST_DESCRIPTION   List Visualization Description Information (Hitlist)        .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_DESC          I IS_OF_TYPE                    Checks Data Type                                            .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_DDIC_CURRENCY             Get: DDIC Value for Currencies                              .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_DDIC_MEASURE              Get: DDIC Value for Amounts                                 .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_DDIC_STRING               Get: Cast DDIC Value on String                              .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_DDIC_XSTRING              Get: Cast DDIC Value on XString                             .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get: Object of Attribute Description                        .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_ID                        Get: ID of Attribute                                        .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_INTEGER_VALUE             Get: Integer Value                                          .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_INTERFACE_VALUE           Get: Interface Value                                        .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_RELATED_VALUE             Get: Reference Values                                       .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_STATE                     Get: State                                                  .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_STRING_VALUE              Get: String Value                                           .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_SINGLE  I GET_DDIC_STRING               Get: Cast DDIC Value on String                              .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_SINGLE  I GET_INTEGER_VALUE             Get: Integer Value                                          .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_SINGLE  I GET_INTERFACE_VALUE           Get: Interface Value                                        .
IF_SRM_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_SINGLE  I GET_STRING_VALUE              Get: String Value                                           .
IF_SRM_ATTR_DESC_AREA_PARA     I IS_AREA_POID_PARA             True, if Area POID Parameter                                .
IF_SRM_ATTR_DESC_AREA_PARA     I IS_SPS_CLASSIFICATION_PARA    True, if SPS Classification Parameter                       .
IF_SRM_ATTR_DESC_AREA_PARA     I SET_DATA                      Set Data                                                    .
IF_SRM_AV_COMPARE              I INTEGER_ID_VALUE              INTEGER_ID_VALUE                                            .
IF_SRM_AV_COMPARE              I STRING_ID_VALUE               STRING_ID_VALUE                                             .
IF_SRM_AV_SINGLE               I DDIC_STRING_GET               Get: Cast DDIC Value on String                              .
IF_SRM_AV_SINGLE               I INTEGER_GET                   Get: Integer Value                                          .
IF_SRM_AV_SINGLE               I INTERFACE_GET                 Get: Interface Value                                        .
IF_SRM_AV_SINGLE               I STRING_GET                    Get: String Value                                           .
IF_SRM_AV_SINGLE               I TEXT_GET                      Get: Short Text                                             .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I DISPATCH_REQUEST              Processing a Request                                        .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I FINISH_ASYNC                  End of an Asynchronous Call (only for passive requests)     .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I GET_CURRENT_POID              Returns Current POID                                        .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I GET_REQUEST_TYPE              Determines Type of Request (inplace, outplace)              .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I GET_SRM                       Returns Reference to IF_SRM                                 .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL            I UNLOAD_CURRENT                Download (Save) Current SP                                  .
IF_SRM_BASE_CONTROL_INT        I GET_CLIENT                    For Internal Use Only (Returns Reference to SP Client)      .
IF_SRM_BSP_CALLBACK            I ON_FINISHED_REQUEST           Callback: Call After Request Ended                          .
IF_SRM_BSP_CALLBACK            I ON_NEW_REQUEST                Callback: Call After New Request                            .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I CHECK_ACTIVITY                Activity Check                                              .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_EXIT_URL                  Gets Exit URL/Set Value/Customizing/Sets Parameters         .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_SP_BSP_CLIENT_EVENT       Generates a BSP Client Event Object                         .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER_REF     Instantiates Controller Reference for Request               .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_SP_CLIENT                 Connect SP Client Object                                    .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_SP_CONTROLLER             Determines Controller Name for POID                         .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I GET_SP_QUERY_CLIENT           Gets Query Client for SP                                    .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_GET                Get Top Element in the Stack (withough changing the stack)  .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_GET_COUNT          Gets Number of Objects in Stack                             .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_POP                Get Request from Navigation Stack                           .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_PUSH               Make Request to Navigation Stack                            .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_REMOVE_ALL         Ends All Requests (e.g. by Closing Browser)                 .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I NAVIGATION_SYNC               Synchronize Navigation Stack with Browser                   .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I RAISE_CLIENT_EVENT            Sets the Client Event Flag                                  .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I SET_EXIT_URL                  Sets the Exit URL                                           .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENTMANAGER       I TAKE_CLIENT_EVENT             Read (and deletes) the Client Event Flag                    .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENT_EVENT        I SEND_ASYNC_ANSWER             Send Asyncronous Response (Ends the SP)                     .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENT_EVENT        I SEND_REQUEST                  Sends Request to the BSP Client Framework                   .
IF_SRM_BSP_CLIENT_EVENT        I SET_CLIENTMANAGER_REF         Sets Reference to the Client Manager                        .
IF_SRM_BSP_SERVICE             I CREATE_REQUEST_OBJECT         Creates an Empty Request Object                             .
IF_SRM_BSP_SERVICE             I GET_REQUEST_URL               Gets URL for Executing a Request                            .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_AREA_ID                 Check: AREA ID                                              .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_CLASS_NAME_FOR_SP_ID    Check: Class Name for SP ID                                 .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_CLASS_ROLE              Check: Class Role ID                                        .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_CLASS_ROLE_FOR_POID     Check: Class Role for POID                                  .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_CLASS_ROLE_FOR_SP_ID    Check: Class Role for SP ID                                 .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_COMPONENT_ROLE          Check: Component Role                                       .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_COMPONENT_ROLE_FOR_POID Check: Component Role for POID                              .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_COMPONENT_ROLE_FOR_SP_IDCheck: Component Role for SP ID                             .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_SPS_ID                  Check: SPS ID                                               .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_SP_ID                   Check: SP ID                                                .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_SP_ID_FOR_AREA_ID       Check: SP ID & AREA ID Together                             .
IF_SRM_CHECK_REGISTRY          I CHECK_SP_TYPE_ID              Check: SP Type ID                                           .
IF_SRM_CHECK_WF_PATH           I CHECK_WF_PATH                 Check Route (General)                                       .
IF_SRM_CLASS_REGISTRY          I CREATE_OBJECT                 Create Instance of Registered Class                         .
IF_SRM_CLASS_REGISTRY          I GET_CLASS_ROLES               Returns a List of all Class Roles in the Registered Class   .
IF_SRM_CLASS_REGISTRY          I INITIALIZE                    Initializing Class Registry                                 .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I ADD_TO_GLOBAL_STACK           Insert Entry into the Global Stack                          .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I CHECK_OBJECT_STACK            Check if entry exists in object stack                       .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I GET_ACTUAL_GUI_TYPE           Get Actual Gui Type                                         .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I GET_GLOBAL_CLIENT_CONTEXT     Get Global Client Context                                   .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I GET_STACK_COUNT               Gets number of items in navigation stack                    .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I INSERT_INTO_STACK_I           Insert Entry into Stack List i                              .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I NAVIGATION_BACK               Navigates back in stack and returns new active element      .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I NAVIGATION_FORWARD            Navigates forward in the stack & returns new active element .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I NAVIGATION_GET_CURRENT        Gets Current Context                                        .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I NAVIGATION_NEW                Navigates to a new stack element                            .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I NAVIGATION_REMOVE             Deletes Object From Navigation                              .
IF_SRM_CLIENTCONTEXT           I SET_ACTUAL_GUI_TYPE           Set actual gui type                                         .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CHECK_EVENT_STACK             Check the Current Event Stack                               .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CHECK_INCOMING_ACTIVITY       Check the incoming target activity                          .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_ACTIVITIES        Connects SPS Activities Object                              .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_AUTHORIZATION     Connects SPS Authorization Object                           .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_MENU              Connects an SPS                                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_VISUALIZATION     Connects an SPS                                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_VISUALIZATION_PASVConnects an SPS                                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I CONNECT_SPS_VISUAL_QUERY      Connects an SPS                                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I DELETE_FROM_EVENT_STACK       Delete Entry from Event Stack                               .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I GET_DEFAULT_ACTIVITY          Determines Default Activity for a POID                      .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I GET_GUI_TYPE                  Get the actual GUI type                                     .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I GET_SPS_POSITION              Gets Position of an Element Type                            .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I GET_SPS_VISUALIZATION         Gets a new instance of the SPS                              .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I GET_SPS_VISUALIZATION_PASV    Gets a new instance of the SPS                              .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I INSERT_INTO_EVENT_STACK       Insert Entry into Event Stack                               .
IF_SRM_CLIENTMANAGER           I WRITE_APPL_LOG                Write Application Log                                       .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_EVENT            I SEND_ASYNC_ANSWER             Send Event SP Client -" RMF                                 .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_EVENT            I SEND_CLOSE                    Close Active Element                                        .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_EVENT            I SEND_REQUEST                  Starts a Request                                            .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_EVENT            I SEND_TITLE                    Set New Title and Status                                    .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I GET_MY_GUI_TYPE               Get the current GUI type                                    .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I GET_MY_STARTING_REF           Get the reference of the starting class                     .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I GET_RESULT                    Gets Result After Executed Operation                        .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I INITIALIZE                    Initialize the Client Framework                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I SET_MY_GUI_TYPE               Set the current GUI type                                    .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME            I SET_MY_STARTING_REF           Set the reference of the starting class                     .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME_BSP        I CHECK_REQUEST                 Checks Whether Activity for Target is Authorized and Defined.
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME_BSP        I CONNECT_SPS_VISUALIZATION     Connects an SPS                                             .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME_BSP        I CREATE_INITIAL_REQUEST        Creation of Initial Request for CFW BSP                     .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_FRAME_BSP        I GET_SP_BSP_NAME               Gets Name of BSP Application of a SP                        .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_STATE            I GET_ALLOWED_SUCCESSORS        Returns all Permitted Successor Statuses                    .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_STATE            I GET_STATE                     Returns Status Value                                        .
IF_SRM_CLIENT_STATE            I SET_STATE                     Set Status Value                                            .
IF_SRM_CLRO_FACTORY            I EXECUTE                       Initializing an Object of the Class Role                    .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_CLASS_BASE                Get: Class Name of Base Class                               .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_CLASS_DEFAULT             Get: Class Name of Default Class                            .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_CLASS_FACTORY             Get: Class Name of Factory Class                            .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_CLRO_FACTORY              GET: Factory Object of Class Role                           .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get: Display Name                                           .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I GET_ID                        GET: Class Role ID                                          .
IF_SRM_CLRO_REGISTRY           I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION              I CHECK                         Connection Check                                            .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION              I CONNECT_REPOSITORY            Load Data from Repository                                   .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION              I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_ATTR         I GET_STRING_VALUE              Get: String Value of a Value Object for Connection Parameter.
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_ATTR         I GET_VALUE                     Get: Value Object of a Connection Parameter                 .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_ATTR         I GET_VALUES                    Get: List of Value Objects of all Connection Parameters     .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_NEW          I NEW                           New Connection Object                                       .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_STATE        I GET_ALLOWED_SUCCESSORS        Returns all Permitted Successor Statuses                    .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_STATE        I GET_STATE                     Returns Status Value                                        .
IF_SRM_CONNECTION_STATE        I SET_STATE                     Set Status Value                                            .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_CONTAINER                 Container of the Element (if Nested)                        .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_CONTAINER_ID              Container ID                                                .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_CONTAINER_POID            Container POID                                              .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_DESCRIPTION               Element Description                                         .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_ID                        ID of element                                               .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_LEVEL                     Level of the Element in the Hierarchy                       .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_PARENT                    Return Parent Element                                       .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_POID                      POID of Element                                             .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_SPS_ID                    List of SPS IDs                                             .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I GET_TYPE                      Element Type                                                .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I HAS_CHILDREN                  Returns whether the element has children                    .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I IS_CONTAINER                  Element is a (Transparent) Container                        .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_CONTAINER                 Container of the Element (if Nested)                        .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_CONTAINER_ID              Container ID                                                .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_CONTAINER_POID            Container POID                                              .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_DESCRIPTION               Element Description                                         .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_HAS_CHILDREN              Set that the element has children                           .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_ID                        Set the Element ID                                          .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_IS_CONTAINER              Element is a (Transparent) Container                        .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_LEVEL                     Level of the Element in the Hierarchy                       .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_PARENT                    Set Parent Element                                          .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_POID                      POID of Element                                             .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_SPS_ID                    List of SPS IDs                                             .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT       I SET_TYPE                      Element Type                                                .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENTS_GET  I EXECUTE                       Find Elements                                               .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENTS_GET  I GET_COLLECTION_ELEMENTS       Return Collection (Elements)                                .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENTS_GET  I HAS_POID_ELEMENTS             Checks whether POID contains (container) elements           .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ADDIT I DELETE_FREE_FIELD             Delete Free Field                                           .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ADDIT I GET_FREE_FIELDS               Return Free Fields                                          .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ADDIT I SET_FREE_FIELDS               Set Free Fields                                             .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ATTR  I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Return Attribute                                            .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ATTR  I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Return Attributes                                           .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ATTR  I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Set Attribute                                               .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_ATTR  I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I GET_LAST_MODIF_DATE           Return Date of Last Change                                  .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I GET_LAST_MODIF_TIME           Return Time of Last Change                                  .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I GET_LAST_MODIF_USER           Return "Last Changed by" Data                               .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I SET_LAST_MODIF_DATE           Set Date of Last Change                                     .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I SET_LAST_MODIF_TIME           Set Time of Last Change                                     .
IF_SRM_CONTAINER_ELEMENT_USER  I SET_LAST_MODIF_USER           Set "Last Changed by" Data                                  .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I CLEAR_BUFFER                  Delete Buffer -" Saves Garbage Collector Work               .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I EXECUTE_AUTOMATION_SET        Execute: Context Automation                                 .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I GET_INTEGER_VALUE             Get: Integer Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter  .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I GET_INTERFACE_VALUE           Get: Interface Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter.
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I GET_STRING_VALUE              Get: String Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter   .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I GET_VALUE                     Get: Value Object of a Context Parameter                    .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I GET_VALUES                    Get: List of Value Objects of all Context Parameters        .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I SET_INTEGER_VALUE             Set: Integer Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter  .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I SET_INTERFACE_VALUE           Set: Interface Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter.
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_ATTR            I SET_STRING_VALUE              Set: String Value of a Value Object for Context Parameter   .
IF_SRM_CONTEXT_AUTOMATION      I SET_VALUES                    SP Fills Context Attributes with Values                     .
IF_SRM_CONTROL                 I DISPATCH_REQUEST              Processing a Request                                        .
IF_SRM_CONTROL                 I GET_ACTIVITY_VISUAL_STATUS    Determines Visual Status of Activity                        .
IF_SRM_CONTROL                 I GET_SRM                       Returns Reference to IF_SRM                                 .
IF_SRM_CONTROL                 I UNLOAD_CURRENT                Download (Save) Current SP                                  .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE     I CONNECT_CONTAINER             Connects Container (SP)                                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE     I GET_INTERFACE                 Deprecated, Use GET_INTERFACE_4_UPD_COLLECTION              .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE     I GET_INTERFACE_4_UPD_COLLECTIONReturns Interface for Change Operations                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE     I IS_CHANGING_SUPPORTED         Returns whether container (SP) supports change operations   .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I ADD_ELEMENT                   Add an Element to the Collection                            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I ADD_ELEMENTS                  Add Two or More Elements to the Collection                  .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I CREATE_ITERATOR               Create/Return Iterator for Collection                       .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Element from Collection                              .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I DELETE_ELEMENT_BY_POS         Delete Element from Collection (Using Position)             .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_DIRECT_CHILDS_OF_ELEMENT  Find Direct Children of an Element                          .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_ELEMENT                   Return Element (Using Index)                                .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_ELEMENTS                  Return All Elements in the Collection                       .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             Return Element (Using ID)                                   .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_ID_OF_ROOT_CONTAINER      Find Container ID                                           .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_INDEX_OF_ELEMENT          Return Index of an Element                                  .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I GET_NUMBER_OF_ELEMENTS        Return Number of Elements in the Collection                 .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I HAS_ELEMENT_CHILDREN          Returns if an element in the collection has children        .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I IS_ELEMENT_EXISTING           Checks if an element exists in the collection               .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I IS_POID_EXISTING              Checks if an element with the specified POID exists         .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT    I SEARCH_ELEMENT_BY_DESCRIPTION Searches for an Element (Description)                       .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_COLLECT_XT I IS_PREV_ELEM_POID_EXISTING    Does another existing element have the same POID?           .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_FILTER     I FILTER_ELEMENT                Filter Element                                              .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I COPY_ITERATOR                 Copy Iterator                                               .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I GET_COLLECTION                Return Existing Collection for the Iterator                 .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I GET_NEXT                      Return Next Element                                         .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I GET_POSITION                  Return Current Position of the Iterator                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I HAS_NEXT                      Does a further element exist?                               .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I RESET                         Reset Iterator to First Element                             .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I SET_BY_ELEMENT                Set Iterator to Element                                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I SET_BY_POSITION               Set Iterator to Certain Position                            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I SET_POSITION_TO_END           Set Position of the Iterator to its End                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMENT_ITERATOR   I SET_POSITION_TO_PREVIOUS      Set Iterator to Previous Element                            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I ADD_ELEMENT                   Add Element to Collection                                   .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I CREATE_ELEMENT                Return Initial New Element                                  .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I GETTING_ELEMENTS_FAILED       An error hos occurred while finding elements                .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I GET_LEVEL_OF_CONTAINER        Return Level of the Container                               .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I GET_PARENT_CONTAINER          Return Parent Container                                     .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I IS_CONTAINER_TO_REOPEN        Is the container to be re-opened?                           .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEMS_GET_HANDLER  I IS_ELEMENT_CONTAINER          Returns whether an element is a container                   .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I ADD_ELEMENT_BY_PARENT         Insert an Element to a Parent Element as a Child            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I ADD_ELEMENT_BY_REFERENCE      Add an Element Using a Reference Element                    .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I CLOSE                         Closes the Container                                        .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete an Element                                           .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I GET_FREE_CHILDREN_ELEMENTS    Free Child Elements (Record Model Structure, Cardinality)   .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I GET_MESSAGE                   Existing Message after Operation                            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I IS_ADDING_OF_ELEMS_SUPPORTED  Does the container support addition of elements?            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I IS_DELETING_OF_ELEMS_SUPPORTEDDoes the container support deletion of elements?            .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I OPEN                          Opens the Container for Changes                             .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I SAVE                          Saves the Changes                                           .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_CHANGE_COLLEC I SET_ELEMENT_COLLECTION        Set Element Collection                                      .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_FILTER_COLLEC I ADD_FILTER                    Add Filter                                                  .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_FILTER_COLLEC I GET_ALL_FILTERS               Return All Filters                                          .
IF_SRM_CONT_ELEM_FILTER_COLLEC I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Collection                                       .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I AREA_ATTR_DESC_STR_TO_OBJ     AREA Attr Desc: Structure -" Object                         .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I POID_DATA_TO_STRING           POID: Conversion of POID Data -" String                     .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I POID_STRING_TO_DATA           POID: Conversion of String -" POID Data                     .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I SPS_ATTR_VALUE_ITAB_TO_OBJS   SPS Attr Value: ITAB -" Object List                         .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I SP_ATTR_DESC_OBJS_TO_ITAB     SP Attr Desc: Object List -" ITAB                           .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I SP_ATTR_DESC_OBJ_TO_STR       SP Attr Desc: Object -" Structure                           .
IF_SRM_CONVERSION_SERVICE      I SP_ATTR_DESC_STR_TO_OBJ       SP Attr Desc: Structure -" Object                           .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I ICON_ID_GET                   ICON_ID_GET                                                 .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I POID_GET                      POID_GET                                                    .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I SET                           SET                                                         .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I SOURCE_POID_GET               SOURCE_POID_GET                                             .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I TEXT_GET                      TEXT_GET                                                    .
IF_SRM_COPYPASTEDATA           I USER_OBJECT_GET               USER_OBJECT_GET                                             .
IF_SRM_CUSTOM_SERVICE_MGR      I CONNECT_SERVICE               Returns Instance of a Service for SPS                       .
IF_SRM_CUSTOM_SERVICE_MGR      I CONNECT_SERVICE_BY_CUSTOMIZINGReturns Instance of a Service for Class Role by SRMCUSTSRV  .
IF_SRM_CUSTOM_SERVICE_MGR      I ENUMERATE_SERVICES            Lists SPS that Implement Each Class Role                    .
IF_SRM_DDIC_BUFFER             I DD_TABL_GET                   DD_TABL_GET                                                 .
IF_SRM_DDIC_BUFFER             I DD_TABL_SET                   DD_TABL_SET                                                 .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I CHECK_VALUE_HELP_AVAILABLE    Check: Input Help Available                                 .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_ALL                       All Information (DD03P)                                     .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_DATA_ELEMENT              Data Element                                                .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_DATA_TYPE                 Data Type                                                   .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_DECIMALS                  Decimal Places                                              .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_DOMAIN                    Domain                                                      .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_LENGTH                    Output Length                                               .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_REFFIELD                  Reference field for currency and qty fields                 .
IF_SRM_DDIC_DETAILS            I GET_REFTABLE                  Table for reference field                                   .
IF_SRM_DDIC_QUERY_INFO         I GET_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR         Returns Description for Table Field                         .
IF_SRM_DDIC_SERVICES           I EXECUTE_VALUE_HELP            Execute Input Help                                          .
IF_SRM_DDIC_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR  I GET_DATA_ELEMENT              Returns Data Element                                        .
IF_SRM_DDIC_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR  I GET_DATA_TYPE                 Returns Data Type                                           .
IF_SRM_DDIC_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR  I GET_DECIMALS                  Returns Decimal Places                                      .
IF_SRM_DDIC_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR  I GET_DOMAIN                    Returns Domains                                             .
IF_SRM_DDIC_TABLE_FIELD_DESCR  I GET_LENGTH                    Returns Length                                              .
IF_SRM_DIS_WFPATH_ACTIVITY     I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Executing an Activity Function                              .
IF_SRM_DIS_WFPATH_ACTIVITY     I PROCESS_BEFORE_DISPLAY        Initializing the Activity                                   .
IF_SRM_DIS_WFPATH_ACTIVITY     I PROCESS_ON_LEAVE              Action When Leaving the Circular                            .
IF_SRM_DIS_WFPATH_ACTIVITY     I PROCESS_ON_SAVE_AND_QUIT      Action When Saving                                          .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I APPLY_LOCK                    Create Lock for this Document                               .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I COPY_PARTIAL                  Copy a given version and variant to new document            .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I CREATE_VERSION                Create New Version of Document                              .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I DELETE                        Delete Document                                             .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I FORCE_VERSION_RELOAD          Look on the DB at next version access                       .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I FREEZE_CURRENT_VERSION        Freeze Current Version                                      .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_COMMIT_MODE               Fetch Commit Mode                                           .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_DM_REPOSITORY             Fetch Repository from GDMA                                  .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_DOC_ID                    Get Documentation ID                                        .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_PROPERTY_INTERFACE        Get  Interface for Property Access                          .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_REPOSITORY_TYPE           Get Repository Type                                         .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_TRANSPORT_INFOS           Get Transport Infos for Whole Document                      .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_UPDATE_MODE               Get Update Mode                                             .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_VARIANT                   Get Variant of the Document                                 .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_VERSION                   Get a Version of the Document                               .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I GET_VERSIONS_INFO             Get Information on All Versions of a Document               .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I IS_AUTHORIZED                 Checks Whether User is Authorised for Particular Activities .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I IS_MODIFIABLE                 Checks Whether Document May Be Modified (is locked or not)  .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I NEW_VARIANT                   Create New Version with New Variant                         .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I REMOVE_LOCK                   Delete Lock for the Document                                .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I SET_COMMIT_MODE               Set Commit Mode                                             .
IF_SRM_DOCUMENT                I SET_UPDATE_MODE               Set Update Mode                                             .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I CLOSE                         Close Document (Write Lock Released)                        .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Create New Document                                         .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_DOCUMENT_ID               Get Document ID                                             .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_DOCUMENT_URL              Get DOCID, CLASS, VERSION and VARIANT                       .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_FUNCTION_LIST             Get Toolbar Functions                                       .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_MIMETYPE                  Determine Mimetype                                          .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_PROPERTIES                Get Properties (Only Properties that are to be Displayed)   .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_VARIANT                   Get Variant                                                 .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I GET_WEBDAV_URL                Get URL for Changing and Saving MS Document                 .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I OPEN_FOR_UPDATE               Open Document (Read-Only)                                   .
IF_SRM_DOCVIEW_BSP             I SET_CONTENT                   Set Document Content with Table Transfer                    .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I GET_DRAGITEM                  Gets POID that is Dragged or Dropped                        .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I GET_DRAGSRC                   Gets POID of the Source of the Dragdrop Process             .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I GET_ICON_ID                   Gets Icon for Dragged Object                                .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I GET_TEXT                      Gets Text for Dragged Object                                .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I GET_USEROBJECT                Gets Additional Information (Free Field)                    .
IF_SRM_DRAGDROPDATA            I SET_DRAGDATA                  Sets Information for DragDrop Process                       .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_GENERAL_DESCRIPTION       General Description Information                             .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_INTEGER_DESCRIPTION       Integer-Specific Description Information                    .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_INTERFACE_DESCRIPTION     Interface-Specific Description Information                  .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_QUERY_DESCRIPTION         Query Description Information (OPTIONAL)                    .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_RELATED_DESC              Sets Reference Field                                        .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_STRING_DESCRIPTION        String-Specific Description Information                     .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_TABFIELD_DESCRIPTION      Table-Field Specific Description Information                .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_VISUAL_DESCRIPTION        Visualization Description Information (OPTIONAL)            .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I SET_VIS_IN_LIST_DESCRIPTION   List Vis. Description Info. [e.g. Hit List Display] (OPT.)  .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I UPDATE_GENERAL_IS_CHECK       General Description: Update IS_CHECK                        .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I UPDATE_GENERAL_IS_GENERATE    General Description: Update IS_GENERATE                     .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I UPDATE_GENERAL_IS_HELP        General Description: Update IS_HELP                         .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I UPDATE_GENERAL_IS_LIST        General Description: Update IS_LIST                         .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_DESC     I UPDATE_GENERAL_TEXT           General Description: Update TEXT                            .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_DDIC_CURRENCY             Set: DDIC Value for Currencies                              .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_DDIC_MEASURE              Set: DDIC Value for Amounts                                 .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_DDIC_STRING               Set: Cast DDIC Value on String                              .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_DDIC_XSTRING              Set: Cast DDIC Value on XString                             .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set: Attribute Description Object                           .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_INTEGER_VALUE             Set: Integer Value                                          .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_INTERFACE_VALUE           Set: Interface Value                                        .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_RELATED_VALUE             Set: Reference Values                                       .
IF_SRM_EDIT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE    I SET_STRING_VALUE              Set: String Value                                           .
IF_SRM_EDIT_AV_SINGLE          I DDIC_STRING_SET               Set: Cast DDIC Value on String                              .
IF_SRM_EDIT_AV_SINGLE          I INTEGER_SET                   Set: Integer Value                                          .
IF_SRM_EDIT_AV_SINGLE          I INTERFACE_SET                 Set: Interface Value                                        .
IF_SRM_EDIT_AV_SINGLE          I STRING_SET                    Set: String Value                                           .
IF_SRM_EDIT_SPS                I CREATE                        Create SPS Entity in Registry                               .
IF_SRM_EDIT_SPS                I GET_NEW_REG                   Factory: Get Handle for Create Method                       .
IF_SRM_ENQUEUE                 I DEQUEUE                       Dequeue                                                     .
IF_SRM_ENQUEUE                 I ENQUEUE                       Enqueue SP Object                                           .
IF_SRM_EXCHANGE_CONTENT        I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of POID Object                                  .
IF_SRM_EXCHANGE_LOG_DATA       I GET_LOG_DATA                  Get Log Information from POID Object                        .
IF_SRM_EXCHANGE_META_DATA      I GET_META_DATA                 Get Metadata of POID Object                                 .
IF_SRM_FILE_TRANSFER           I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_FILE_TRANSFER           I SET_CONTENT                   Set Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I ADD_INHERITED_PROPERTIES      Add Properties that are inherited between versions          .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I COPY_PARTIAL                  Only Copy One Version/Variant of Document                   .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Create a Document (from New)                                .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I CREATE_SP_POID                Create an SP-POID for the Document Specified                .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_CONNECTION_PARAM          Get Document Class for an Element Type                      .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_DM_REPOSITORY             Fetch Repository from GDMA                                  .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_DOCUMENT                  Returns the Document Used by the SP                         .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_DOC_CLASS                 Get Document Class for an Element Type                      .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_PROPERTY_TYPES            Get Information on Existing Attribute Types of a Doc. Class .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I GET_QUERY                     Supplies Reference to IF_DM_QUERY                           .
IF_SRM_GENERIC_SP              I IS_AUTHORIZED                 Checks Whether User is Authorised for Particular Activities .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I GET_ICON                      Gets Icon for Element                                       .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I GET_PARA_BEE                  Gets Visualization for Search Parameters                    .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I GET_PARA_TAB                  Gets Search Parameter Table from HTTP Request               .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I GET_RESULT_FIELDCAT           Gets Field Catalog of Result Display                        .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I GET_TITLE                     Gets Title of Search Function                               .
IF_SRM_GENSP_QUERY_EXT         I RENDER_CELL                   Gets Cell Visualization                                     .
IF_SRM_GSP_FILE_TRANSFER       I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_GSP_FILE_TRANSFER       I SET_CONTENT                   Set Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_GSP_IMPL                I CONNECT                       Connect to Document                                         .
IF_SRM_GSP_IMPL                I GET_PROT_DATA                 Get Protected Data from Implementation                      .
IF_SRM_GSP_IMPL                I SET_POID                      Sets POID Object                                            .
IF_SRM_GSP_POID_INFO           I GET_NAME                      Get Object Names for POID ID                                .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I CLEAR_CACHE                   Discard Buffered Attribute Values                           .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Delete Attributes                                           .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I GET_MAINT_PROPERTIES          Get Maintainable Properties of the Information Object       .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I GET_PROPERTIES                Getting Properties                                          .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I GET_PROPERTY                  Get an Attribute                                            .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I GET_PROPERTY_TYPES            Get Attributes for Properties                               .
IF_SRM_GSP_PROPERTIES          I SET_PROPERTIES                Setting Properties                                          .
IF_SRM_GSP_QUERY               I EXECUTE                       Carry Out Search                                            .
IF_SRM_GSP_QUERY               I IS_PROP_VALUE_UNIQUE          Checks whether a property value is unique                   .
IF_SRM_GSP_SRM_STATE           I GET_SRM_STATE_PROFILE          Determine Status Profile                                   .
IF_SRM_GSP_SRM_STATE           I IS_SEQUEL_SRM_STATE_VALID     Returns whether sequence status is valid                    .
IF_SRM_GSP_SRM_STATE           I IS_SRM_STATE_ACTIVE           Checks whether property SRM_STATE is used/active            .
IF_SRM_GSP_SRM_STATE           I SET_SRM_STATE_INIT            Initialization of Property SRM_STATE                        .
IF_SRM_GSP_TAB_TRANSFER        I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_GSP_TAB_TRANSFER        I SET_CONTENT                   Set Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_GSP_URL_TRANSFER        I CONFIRM_PUT                   Transfer Data (After calling Get_url_for_Put)               .
IF_SRM_GSP_URL_TRANSFER        I GET_URL_FOR_GET               Get URL for Selecting Content                               .
IF_SRM_GSP_URL_TRANSFER        I GET_URL_FOR_PUT               Get URL for Writing Content                                 .
IF_SRM_LOC_BE                  I GET_OPTIONS                   Provide Visualization Options                               .
IF_SRM_LOC_BE                  I GET_POID_FOR_ENTRY            Provides POID Object for List Entry                         .
IF_SRM_LOC_BE                  I GET_QUERY_FIELDCAT            Deliver Field Catlog                                        .
IF_SRM_LOC_BE                  I GET_QUERY_RESULT              Perform Search                                              .
IF_SRM_LOC_BE                  I GET_SELECTION_PARA            Read Attribute List                                         .
IF_SRM_LOC_SAPGUI_FE           I DO_QUERY                      Search                                                      .
IF_SRM_LOC_SAPGUI_FE           I GET_SELECTED_ELEMENTS         Provides list of selected elements (as POID)                .
IF_SRM_LOC_SAPGUI_FE           I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_SRM_LOC_SAPGUI_FE           I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Context                                                .
IF_SRM_LOC_SAPGUI_FE           I SHOW                          Display                                                     .
IF_SRM_MDL_API                 I GET_ALL_DIRECT_CHILDS         GET_ALL_DIRECT_CHILDS                                       .
IF_SRM_MDL_API                 I GET_ALL_ELEMENTS              GET_ALL_ELEMENTS                                            .
IF_SRM_MDL_API                 I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID                                           .
IF_SRM_MDL_API                 I GET_FIRST_ID_BY_ANCHOR        GET_FIRST_ID_BY_ANCHOR                                      .
IF_SRM_MDL_API_ELEMENT         I GET_EXPIRY                    Currently Only C_EXPIRY_UNLIMITED                           .
IF_SRM_MDL_API_ELEMENT         I GET_FREE_ATTRIBUTES           Among Others C_ANCHOR_NAME                                  .
IF_SRM_MDL_API_ELEMENT         I GET_LAST_MODIFICATION         YYYY-MM-DD and HH:MM:SS                                     .
IF_SRM_MDL_API_ELEMENT         I GET_STATE                     C_STATE_INIT or C_STATE_SET or C_STATE_FOLDER               .
IF_SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO_ARCHIVE I GET_SPECIFIC_INFO_LIST        List of Specific Attribute Value Objects                    .
IF_SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO_ARCHIVE I GET_STANDARD_INFO_LIST        List SP Standard Attribute Values                           .
IF_SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO_SP      I GET_SPECIFIC_INFO_LIST        List of Specific Attribute Value Objects                    .
IF_SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO_SP      I GET_STANDARD_INFO_LIST        List SP Standard Attribute Values                           .
IF_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY          I CREATE_CLASS_REGISTRY         Create Class Registry Object                                .
IF_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY          I CREATE_CLRO_REGISTRY          Create Class Role Registry Object                           .
IF_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY          I CREATE_SP_OBJ_BY_ROLE_POID    Create SP Object for: Class Role & POID                     .
IF_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY          I CREATE_SP_OBJ_BY_ROLE_SP_ID   Create SP Object for: Class Role & SP ID                    .
IF_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY          I CREATE_SRM_OBJ_BY_ROLE        Create SRM Object for: Class Role                           .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER               I ADD_FAVORITE                  Add a Favorite                                              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER               I ADD_HISTORY                   Adds an Element to the Worklist                             .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER               I DEL_HISTORY                   Deletes an Element from the Worklist                        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER               I DISPLAY_WHEREUSED             Display Where-Used List for Given POID Object               .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER               I SEND_REQUEST                  Sends Request Through Organizer (for Plug-Ins)              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I CHECK_RMS_ID                  Checks Existence of RMS ID and Authorization                .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_DELETE               Deletes an Element from the Favorites (Recursive if Needed) .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_INSERT               Sets a New Element in Favorites                             .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_READ                 Reads the Favorites List                                    .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_READ_REMOTE          Read Favorites (Remote)                                     .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_REMOVE_ELEMENT       Deletes an Element From the Favorites                       .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_RENAME               Rename an Element from the Favorites                        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_WRITE                Writes the Favorites List                                   .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I FAVORITE_WRITE_REMOTE         Write Favorites (Remote)                                    .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I GET_RMS_ID_LIST               Gets List of the Permissible RMSIDs for the User (Buffered) .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I GET_VIEW_LIST                 Gets List of Defined Views for User                         .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I HISTORY_ADD_ELEMENT           Adds an Element to the History                              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I HISTORY_READ                  Reads the Complete History                                  .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I HISTORY_READ_REMOTE           Read History (Remote Call)                                  .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I HISTORY_REMOVE_ELEMENT        Deletes an Element From the History                         .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I PREFERENCES_GET               Reads Preferences                                           .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I PREFERENCES_SET               Sets Preferences                                            .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_ADD_UPDATE       Add or Update Possible Element in Resubmission              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_CHECK            Checks Resubmission Entry                                   .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_GET              Reads List of Resubmission Entries                          .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_GET_COUNT        Determine Number of Elements (Quick)                        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_GET_FOR_POID     Checks Whether a POID Is Already in the Resubmission        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_GET_WHEREUSED    Where-Used List for Resubmission Element                    .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I RESUBMISSION_REMOVE           Delete Element                                              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I SET_COMPROLE_FILTER           Set Filter (Component Role)                                 .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I VIEW_CREATE_FROM_REGISTRY     Generate Default View from Registry                         .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BE            I VIEW_READ_REMOTE              Read View (Remote)                                          .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_CURRENT_NODE              Returns Current Node                                        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_NODE_INFO                 Gets Information for Current Node                           .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_NODE_LAUNCH_REQUEST       Gets Request to Start Node                                  .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_NODE_POID                 Gets POID for Node ID                                       .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_PATH                      Gets Path for Specified Node                                .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_POID_LAUNCH_REQUEST       Generates Request for POID                                  .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_REQUEST_URL               Gets URL for Node ID                                        .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_SUBFOLDERS                Gets Current Directories of Role for Superordinate Node     .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_SUBNODES                  Gets All Nodes (Not Folders) Beneath a Node                 .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I GET_TOP_NODE_DESC             Gets Top Node with Description                              .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_BSP           I SET_CURRENT_NODE              Sets Current Node                                           .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_PLUGIN_SGW    I ON_GET_TITLE                  Gets Plug-In Title                                          .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_PLUGIN_SGW    I ON_HIDE                       Hide Plug-In                                                .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_PLUGIN_SGW    I ON_INITIALIZE                 Initialize Plug-In                                          .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_PLUGIN_SGW    I ON_REQUEST_ANSWER             Request Started by Plug-In Answered                         .
IF_SRM_ORGANIZER_PLUGIN_SGW    I ON_SHOW                       Display Plug-In                                             .
IF_SRM_PBO                     I PROCESS_BEFORE_OUTPUT         Method that is to be executed before screen output          .
IF_SRM_PLAN                    I GET_FPLAN_TERMINOLOGY         Get External Designation for File Plan                      .
IF_SRM_PLAN_TREE               I SET_POIDS_ICON                SET_POIDS_ICON                                              .
IF_SRM_PLAN_TREE               I UNSET_POIDS_ICON              UNSET_POIDS_ICON                                            .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_AREA_ID                   Get: Area ID                                                .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_AREA_POID                 Get: Area POID                                              .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_AREA_POID_VALUE_BY_ID     Get: Area POID Attribute Value for an ID                    .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_AREA_REGISTRY             Get: Area Registry Object                                   .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_POID_DIRECTORY_ID         Get: POID Directory ID (INITIAL if not entered)             .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_POID_STATE                Get: POID State                                             .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SPS_ID                    Get: SPS ID                                                 .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SPS_REGISTRY              Get: SPS Registry Object                                    .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SP_ID                     Get: SP ID                                                  .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SP_POID                   Get: SP POID                                                .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SP_POID_VALUE_BY_ID       Get: SP POID Attribute Value for ID                         .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SP_REGISTRY               Get: SP Registry Object                                     .
IF_SRM_POID                    I GET_SRM_POID                  Get: SRM POID                                               .
IF_SRM_POID                    I SET_SP_POID                   Set: SP POID                                                .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER            I GET_CONTROL_SETTINGS          Get: Interface to Control Settings                          .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER            I GET_EXECUTION                 Get: Interface for Execution                                .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER_CONTROL    I SET_MULTIPLE_SELECTION        Set: Multiple Selection Possible (IF SRM="TRUE)             .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER_CONTROL    I SET_TITLE                     Set Title Bar                                               .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER_EXECUTION  I DISPLAY                       Display POID Browser                                        .
IF_SRM_POID_BROWSER_EXECUTION  I SET_POID_LIST                 Set: List of POID Objects (maximum 500 POIDs)               .
IF_SRM_POID_BUFFER             I DELETE_POID                   Delete POID Buffer with POID Object                         .
IF_SRM_POID_BUFFER             I GET_POID                      Read POID Buffer with POID Buffer ID                        .
IF_SRM_POID_BUFFER             I SET_POID                      Set POID Buffer with POID Object                            .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_DIR_CHECK            Get: Interface to Check Directory                           .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_DIR_EDIT             Get: Interface to Edit Directory                            .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_DIR_QUERY            Get: Interface to Query Directory                           .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_RELA_CHECK           Get: Interface to Check Relation                            .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_RELA_EDIT            Get: Interface to Edit Relation                             .
IF_SRM_POID_DIRECTORY          I GET_POID_RELA_QUERY           Get: Interface to Query Relation                            .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_CHECK          I CHECK                         Check with POID Object                                      .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_CHECK          I CHECK_BY_ID                   Check with POID ID                                          .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_EDIT           I CREATE                        Create Entry                                                .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_EDIT           I DELETE                        Delete Entry with POID Object                               .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_EDIT           I DELETE_BY_ID                  Delete Entry with POID ID                                   .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_QUERY          I GET_ID                        Returns POID Directory ID for POID Object                   .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_QUERY          I GET_ID_BY_SEARCH_KEY          Returns List of POID Directory IDs for Search KEy           .
IF_SRM_POID_DIR_QUERY          I GET_POID_BY_ID                Returns POID Object for POID Directory ID                   .
IF_SRM_POID_HELPER             I GET_HASH_STRING               Get: String for Forming Hash Value                          .
IF_SRM_POID_HELPER             I GET_HASH_VALUE                Get: Hash Value                                             .
IF_SRM_POID_HELPER             I GET_SP_POID_VALUES            Get: SP POID Value Objects                                  .
IF_SRM_POID_HELPER             I SET_MODEL_POID_DATA           Set: Model POID Data                                        .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_CHECK         I CHECK                         Check with POID Objects                                     .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_CHECK         I CHECK_BY_ID                   Check with POID IDs                                         .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_EDIT          I CREATE                        Create Relation                                             .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_EDIT          I DELETE                        Delete Entry with POID Object                               .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_EDIT          I DELETE_BY_ID                  Delete Entry with POID ID                                   .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_QUERY         I GET_POID1_IDS_BY_POID2_ID     Returns List of POID 1 IDs for a POID 2 ID                  .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_QUERY         I GET_POID1_IDS_BY_RELATION_TYPEGets List of POID 1 IDs for Relation Type                   .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_QUERY         I GET_POID2_COUNT_BY_POID1_A_RELGets Number of POID 2 for POID 1 and Relation Type          .
IF_SRM_POID_RELA_QUERY         I GET_POID2_IDS_BY_POID1_ID     Returns List of POID 2 IDs for a POID 1 ID                  .
IF_SRM_POID_REPOSITORY         I DELETE_POID                   Delete                                                      .
IF_SRM_POID_REPOSITORY         I GET_POID                      Read                                                        .
IF_SRM_POID_REPOSITORY         I SET_POID                      Write                                                       .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_CORE    I ADD_SPOOL_PART                Add Spool Request to Composite                              .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_CORE    I CLOSE_PRINT_JOB               Close Print Job                                             .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_CORE    I GET_PRINT_PARAMS              Get Print/Archiving Parameter of Job                        .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_CORE    I OPEN_PRINT_JOB                Open New Print Job                                          .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_XDC     I IS_DOCUMENT_SUPPORTED         Checks Whether at Least One Comp./MIME Type Can Be Printed  .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_XDC     I IS_MIMETYPE_SUPPORTED         Specifies Whether MIME Type of Converter Server Supported   .
IF_SRM_PRINT_COMPOSITE_XDC     I PRINT_DOCUMENT_TO_CONVERT     Print Document for Conversion with XDC Interface            .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Delete Attributes                                           .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I GET_MAINT_PROPERTIES          Get Maintainable Properties of the Information Object       .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I GET_PROPERTIES                Getting Properties                                          .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I GET_PROPERTY                  Get an Attribute                                            .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I GET_PROPERTY_TYPES            Get Attributes for Properties                               .
IF_SRM_PROPERTIES              I SET_PROPERTIES                Setting Properties                                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_BSP                I CONNECT                       CONNECT                                                     .
IF_SRM_PROP_BSP                I GET_NAME_VALUE_TAB            GET_NAME_VALUE_TAB                                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT            I SPS_SUBTYPE_GET               If element type (Model POID) insufficient, such as case type.
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT            I SPS_SUBTYPE_SET               If element type (Model POID) insufficient, such as case type.
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT            I USER_OBJECT_GET               User Object                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT            I USER_OBJECT_SET               User Object                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_CROSS_QY   I SPS_TAB_GET                   SPS_TAB_GET                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_CROSS_QY   I SPS_TAB_SET                   SPS_TAB_SET                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_PRINT      I MODE_GET                      MODE_GET                                                    .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_PRINT      I MODE_SET                      MODE_SET                                                    .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_PRINT      I USER_OBJECT_GET               USER_OBJECT_GET                                             .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_PRINT      I USER_OBJECT_SET               USER_OBJECT_SET                                             .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I ALL_GET                       Get All                                                     .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I ALL_SET                       set all                                                     .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CALLED_BY_CROSS_QUERY_GET     CALLED_BY_CROSS_QUERY_GET                                   .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CALLED_BY_CROSS_QUERY_SET     CALLED_BY_CROSS_QUERY_SET                                   .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CASE_SENSITIVE_GET            CASE_SENSITIVE_GET                                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CASE_SENSITIVE_SET            CASE_SENSITIVE_SET                                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CURRENT_VERSION_ONLY_GET      CURRENT_VERSION_ONLY_GET                                    .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I CURRENT_VERSION_ONLY_SET      CURRENT_VERSION_ONLY_SET                                    .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I FUZZY_SEARCH_GET              FUZZY_SEARCH_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I FUZZY_SEARCH_SET              FUZZY_SEARCH_SET                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I MAX_HITS_GET                  MAX_HITS_GET                                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I MAX_HITS_SET                  MAX_HITS_SET                                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I NEAR_BY_GET                   NEAR_BY_GET                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_QUERY      I NEAR_BY_SET                   NEAR_BY_SET                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I REQUEST_GET                   Client Frame Request                                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I REQUEST_SET                   Client Frame Request                                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I SOURCE_POID_GET               Source POID                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I SOURCE_POID_SET               Source POID                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I TEMPLATE_POID_GET             Template POID: Record Model, Document Template              .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_REG        I TEMPLATE_POID_SET             Template POID: Record Model, Document Template              .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I DO_LOCK_GET                   Lock in MODE_MODIFY?                                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I DO_LOCK_SET                   Lock in MODE_MODIFY?                                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I MODE_GET                      MODE_DISPLAY, MODE_MODIFY etc.                              .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I MODE_SET                      MODE_DISPLAY, MODE_MODIFY etc.                              .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I PARENT_CONT_GET               parent container                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I PARENT_CONT_SET               parent container                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I PLACE_GET                     PLACE_IN, PLACE_OUT                                         .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I PLACE_SET                     PLACE_IN, PLACE_OUT                                         .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I UI_GET                        UI_SAPGUI, UI_BSP etc.                                      .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I UI_SET                        UI_SAPGUI, UI_BSP etc.                                      .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I USER_OBJECT_GET               User Object                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_CONTEXT_VIS        I USER_OBJECT_SET               User Object                                                 .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I CHANGE_PROPERTIES             Changing an Attribute Record                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Existence of Attribute Record                         .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I CREATE_PROPERTIES             Creation of a New Attribute Record                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I DELETE_PROPERTIES             Deletion of an Attribute Record                             .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I FIND                          Attribute Records Search Using Search Criteria              .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I READ_ADMIN_DATA               Read Administration Data of an Attribute Record             .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I READ_PROPERTIES               Read Attributes (Transfer as Name Value Table)              .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I READ_PROPERTIES_MULTI         Read Attributes for More than One Record                    .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I READ_PROPERTIES_REF           Read Attributes (Transfer as Date Reference)                .
IF_SRM_PROP_PERS_API           I READ_PROPERTY                 Read One Attribute                                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I CHECK_REFERENCE               Checks Unique ID                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I GENERATE_FIRST_REFERENCE      Generates Unique ID for New Object                          .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I GENERATE_REFERENCE            Generates Unique ID                                         .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I GET_DESCRIPTION_FOR_RULENAME  Gets Description for Given Rule Name                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I GET_IF_SRM_REFERENCE          Gets Record Number Generator                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I GET_USE_DEFAULTS              Gets Setting: Use User Data for Generation                  .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I INIT_USE_DEFAULTS             Initializes Setting: Use User Data for Generation           .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I SET_USE_DEFAULTS              Sets Setting: Use User Data for Generation                  .
IF_SRM_PROP_REFERENCE          I TOGGLE_USE_DEFAULTS           Switches Setting: Use User Data for Generation              .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I HANDLE_CHECK                  HANDLE_CHECK                                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I HANDLE_OK                     HANDLE_OK                                                   .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I HANDLE_PRINT                  HANDLE_PRINT                                                .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I HANDLE_PRINT_BARCODE          HANDLE_PRINT_BARCODE                                        .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I INITIALIZE                    INITIALIZE                                                  .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I MAX_COLUMNNO_GET              MAX_COLUMNNO_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_PROP_VIS_SAPGUI         I MAX_ROWNO_GET                 MAX_ROWNO_GET                                               .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL                I IS_PROTOCOL_ACTIVE            Determine Whether Logging is Active                         .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL                I READ_OPERATIONS               Reading Log Entries                                         .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL                I SET_POID_INFO_HANDLER         Sets Pointer for Obtaining POID Information                 .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL                I WRITE_OPERATION               Logging an Operation                                        .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL_CONFIG         I GET_FLAG_NOT_DEL              Get Flag LOG_NOT_DEL                                        .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL_CONFIG         I GET_KEEP_DAYS                 Get Log: Keep Time of SPS in Days                           .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL_CONFIG         I GET_LEVEL                     Get Log Level of SPS                                        .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL_CONFIG         I IS_ACTIVE                     Check if logging is turned off for all SPS                  .
IF_SRM_PROTOCOL_CONFIG         I SET_ACTIVE                    Turn Logging On/Off for all SPS                             .
IF_SRM_QUERY                   I DO_PROPERTY_QUERY             Execute Search                                              .
IF_SRM_QUERY                   I GET_DETAIL                    Supply Details (POID) of Search Result                      .
IF_SRM_QUERY                   I GET_INSTANCE                  Supplies Instance of IF_SRM_QUERY                           .
IF_SRM_QUERY                   I GET_PROPERTIES                Get Attributes of Object List                               .
IF_SRM_QUERY_AREA              I GET_REG                       Returns List of all AREA Registry Objects                   .
IF_SRM_QUERY_AREA              I GET_REG_BY_ID                 Returns Area Registry Object for Area ID                    .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS             I CONNECT_REG_FOR_SP_BY_ROLE_SP Returns Class Registry for SP for Role with SP              .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS             I CONNECT_REG_FOR_SP_BY_RO_POID Returns Class Registry for SP to Role with POID             .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS             I CONNECT_REG_FOR_SRM_BY_ROLE   Returns Class Registry for SRM to Role                      .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS             I GET_NAME_FOR_SP_BY_ROLE       Returns SP Class Name to Class Role                         .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS             I GET_NAME_FOR_SRM_BY_ROLE      GET: SRM Class Name for SRM Class Role                      .
IF_SRM_QUERY_CLASS_ROLE        I CONNECT_REG_BY_CLRO_ID        Connect: Class Role Registry Object to ID of Class Role     .
IF_SRM_QUERY_POID              I CONNECT_INSTANCE              Connected Reference to Instance POID (With Buffer)          .
IF_SRM_QUERY_POID              I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns Reference to Instance POID (Without Buffer)         .
IF_SRM_QUERY_POID              I GET_MODEL                     Returns Reference to Model POID (Without Buffer)            .
IF_SRM_QUERY_SP                I GET_REG_BY_ID                 Connects SP Registry Object to SP ID                        .
IF_SRM_QUERY_SPS               I GET_REG                       Connects List of all Element Type Registry Objects          .
IF_SRM_QUERY_SPS               I GET_REG_BY_AREA_CLASSI        Connects List of ET Registry Objects for AREA Classification.
IF_SRM_QUERY_SPS               I GET_REG_BY_AREA_ID            Connects List of all ET Registry Objects for AREA ID        .
IF_SRM_QUERY_SPS               I GET_REG_BY_CONNECTION_VALUE   Connects List of SPS Registry Objects to Connection Value   .
IF_SRM_QUERY_SPS               I GET_REG_BY_ID                 Connects Element Type Registry Object for Element Type ID.  .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I ADD_ROLE                      Add Role to Record Element                                  .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I DELETE_ELEMENT                An Element is Deleted                                       .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I DELETE_RECORD                 Record Will be Deleted                                      .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I DISPLAY_ELEMENT               An Element is Displayed                                     .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I DISPLAY_RECORD                File is Displayed                                           .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I INSERT_ELEMENT                A New Element is Inserted                                   .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I MODIFY_ELEMENT                Element Being Changed                                       .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I MODIFY_RECORD                 Record Opened for Modification                              .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I MOVE_ELEMENT                  An Element is Moved to the File                             .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I PRINT_RECORD                  Print Record                                                .
IF_SRM_RECPROTOCOL             I REMOVE_ROLE                   Delete Role Assignment for Record Element                   .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I CREATE_RUN                    Create New Operation Run                                    .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I GET_FACILITY                  Return Setup/Tool for Operation Run                         .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I GET_IF_SRM                    SRM Handle                                                  .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I GET_PARAMETERS                Return Operation Parameters                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I GET_RUNS                      Return Operation Runs                                       .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I IS_FACILITY_EXISTING          Returns whether a setup/tool exists                         .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I SET_FACILITY                  Set Setup/Tool for Operation Run                            .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPERATION     I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Operation Parameters                                    .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_OBJ_ITER I GET_NEXT                      Return Next Object                                          .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_OBJ_ITER I HAS_NEXT                      Does a further object exist?                                .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_OBJ_ITER I RESET                         Reset Iterator to First Object                              .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I CREATE_ITERATOR_4_RUN_OBJS    Iterator for Participating Objects                          .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I EXCECUTE_FOR_POID             Execute Recursive Operatoin on POID                         .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I EXECUTE                       Execute Recursive Operatoin                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I GET_OPERATION                 Return Associated Operation                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I GET_RESULT                    Get Result for Recursive Operation                          .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I GET_RUN_OBJECTS               Return Participating Objects                                .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I GET_SP_INTERFACE              Return Interface for Participating SP                       .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I GET_START_POID                Return Start POID                                           .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I REGISTER_POID                 Register Participating POID                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN      I SET_RESULT                    Set Result for Rec. Operation                               .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_EXCEPTION                 Return Class-Based Exception                                .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_LEVEL                     Return Hierarchy Level of an Object                         .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_PARENT                    Return Parent Run Object                                    .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_POID                      Return POID                                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_RESULT                    Return Result for an Object                                 .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I GET_STATE                     Get Status                                                  .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I SET_EXCEPTION                 Set Class-Based Exception if Errors Arise                   .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I SET_LEVEL                     Set Hierarchy Level of an Object                            .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I SET_RESULT                    Set Result for an Object                                    .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_RUN_OBJ  I SET_STATE                     Set Status                                                  .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_OPER_TEMPL_SP I EXECUTE                       Execution of the Recursive Operation                        .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_SP_HANDLER    I CREATE_HANDLER                Create Handler                                              .
IF_SRM_RECURSIVE_SP_HANDLER    I EXECUTE_FOR_POID              Execute for POID (Called up by Recursive Operation)         .
IF_SRM_REC_API                 I GET_ALL_POIDS                 GET_ALL_POIDS                                               .
IF_SRM_REC_CHECK               I BEFORE_DELETE                 Time Before Deleting  Record Element (POID)                 .
IF_SRM_REC_CHECK               I BEFORE_DELETE_RECORD          Time Before Deleting the Record                             .
IF_SRM_REC_CHECK               I BEFORE_DROP                   Time Before Drop Record Element (POID)                      .
IF_SRM_REC_CHECK               I BEFORE_INSERT                 Time Before Inserting Element                               .
IF_SRM_REC_CHECK               I BEFORE_SAVE                   Time Before Saving a Record Element                         .
IF_SRM_REC_DEFAULTS            I DESCRIPTION_GET               Initial Text for Top Nodes (For Example, in CREATE)         .
IF_SRM_REC_DEFAULTS            I SEMANTIC_ID_GET               Initial Text for Unique Name (for Example in CREATE)        .
IF_SRM_REC_TIMES               I AFTER_SAVE                    Directly After Saving the Record, But Before Commit         .
IF_SRM_REC_TIMES               I BEFORE_PASTE_DIALOG           Insert 'Name/Everything' for Element                        .
IF_SRM_REC_TIMES               I BEFORE_PASTE_SUBTREE_DIALOG   Dialog: Insert Element Before or After                      .
IF_SRM_REC_TIMES               I BEFORE_PASTE_TREENODE_DIALOG  Insert Dialog Node to Node or Subnode                       .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I CHECK_REFERENCE               Check Record Number                                         .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I CREATE_REFERENCE              Create Record Number                                        .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I EVAL_ELEMENT                  Evaluate a Rule Element (As in Generation)                  .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I GET_NEW_REFERENCE_SESSION     Gets New Session for Generating Record Numbers              .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I GET_REFERENCE_PARTS           Get Part of a Record Number                                 .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I GET_RULE_DEFINITION           Read a Rule Definition                                      .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I GET_RULE_NAME                 Get Name of Rule                                            .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I GET_VALUE_FROM_REFERENCE      Gets Value of Rule Element (from Elem. Name) from Rec. No.  .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I PRESET_ELEMENT_VALUE          Reserve Value for Rule Element with Given Name (Before Gen.).
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I REMOVE_REFERENCE              Deletes Saved Parts of Record Number                        .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I RESERVE_REFERENCE             Reserve Record Number (if required)                         .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE               I UNRESERVE_REFERENCE           Unreserve Reservation of a Record Number                    .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE_SESSION       I CHECK_AND_PRERESERVE          Checks Record Number and Creates Preliminary Reservation    .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE_SESSION       I CREATE_AND_PRERESERVE         Creates Record Number and Creates Preliminary Reservation   .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE_SESSION       I DESTROY                       Ends Session, Deletes Preliminary Reservations              .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE_SESSION       I GET_IF_SRM_REFERENCE          Gets Record Number Generator                                .
IF_SRM_REFERENCE_SESSION       I SAVE_PRERESERVED              Reserves Last Prelim. Reserved Record No., Deletes Others   .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_ANALYZER       I ANALYZE_CLASS_FOR_REGISTRATIONAnalyzes Class for Registration                             .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_ANALYZER       I CHECK_BASE_CLASS_FOR_NAME     Check: Basis Class for Class Name                           .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_ANALYZER       I CHECK_BASE_CLASS_FOR_OBJECT   Check: Basis Class for Object                               .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_ANALYZER       I CHECK_SPS_PARA_VALUE_TO_DESCR Analyzes Whether SPS Para Value Compatible with Para Descr. .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_ANALYZER       I GET_POSSIBLE_CLASS_ROLES      Get: List of Possible Class Roles of a Class.               .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_BROWSER        I GET_CONTROL_SETTINGS          Get: Interface to Control Settings                          .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_BROWSER        I GET_VIEW_AREA_PARA_VALUE_1    View: Area -" Para Def  -" Para Value                       .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_BROWSER        I GET_VIEW_SPS_1                View: Area -" SP -" SPS                                     .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_BROWSER        I GET_VIEW_SPS_2                View: Area -" Classi Para Def -" Classi Para Value -" SPS   .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I FILL_COLUMN_1_WITH            Content of Column 1 ( Default TYPE )                        .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I FILL_COLUMN_2_WITH            Content of Column 2 (Default DISPLAY NAME )                 .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I FILL_COLUMN_HIERARCHY_WITH    Content of Column HIERARCHY (Default ID)                    .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I SET_ICON_TYPE                 Registry Icons/Application Icons or No Icons                .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I SET_MULTIPLE_SELECTION        Set: Multiple Selection Possible (IF SRM="TRUE)             .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I SET_TITLE                     Set Title                                                   .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I SHOW_COLUMN_1                 Display Column 1 (Default TRUE)                             .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_CONTROL        I SHOW_COLUMN_2                 Display Column 2 (Default TRUE)                             .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I DISPLAY                       Display Registry                                            .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_AREA_ID                   Set: Area ID (Default '*')                                  .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_FLAG_AREA_POID            Set: AREA_POID Parameter (Default: TRUE and FALSE)          .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_FLAG_SPS_CLASSIFICATION   Set: SPS Classification Parameter (Default: TRUE and FALSE) .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_PARA_DEFINITION_ID        Set: Parameter Definition ID (Default '*')                  .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_PARA_VALUE                Set: Parameter Value (Default '*')                          .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_APV_1     I SET_PARA_VALUE_ID             Set: Parameter Value ID (Default '*')                       .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I DISPLAY                       Display Registry                                            .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_AREA_ID                   Set: Area ID (Default '*')                                  .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_CLASS_ROLE_ID             Set: Class Role ID (Default '*')                            .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_SPS_ID                    Set: SPS ID (Default '*')                                   .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_SPS_ID_LIST               Set: List of SpsIds (Filter)                                .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_SP_ID                     Set: SP ID (Default '*')                                    .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_SP_ID_LIST                Set: List of SpIds (Filter)                                 .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_1     I SET_SP_TYPE_ID                Set: SP Type ID (Default '*')                               .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I DISPLAY                       Display Registry                                            .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_AREA_ID                   Set: Area ID (Default '*')                                  .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_CLASS_ROLE_ID             Set: Class Role ID (Default '*')                            .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_PARA_DEFINITION_ID        Set: Parameter Definition ID (Default '*')                  .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_PARA_VALUE                Set: Parameter Value (Default '*')                          .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_SPS_ID                    Set: SPS ID (Default '*')                                   .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_SPS_ID_LIST               Set: List of SpsIds (Filter)                                .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_SP_ID                     Set: SP ID (Default '*')                                    .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_SP_ID_LIST                Set: List of SpIds (Filter)                                 .
IF_SRM_REGISTRY_VIEW_SPS_2     I SET_SP_TYPE_ID                Set: SP Type ID (Default '*')                               .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I ADD_ERROR_MESSAGE             Add Error Output (for BSP Only)                             .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_ACTIVITY                  Gets activity                                               .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_ACTIVITY_STATE            Gets completion status of activity                          .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_DEST_POID                 Gets Dest POID                                              .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_ERROR_MESSAGES            List of Error Messages in Request Processing                .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_PARAMETER                 Gets Parameter                                              .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_REQUEST_ID                Gets Request ID                                             .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_RESULT                    Gets result                                                 .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_RESULT_IS_VISIBLE         Get 'result is visible' flag from request                   .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_SOURCE_POID               Gets Source POID                                            .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I GET_UPDATE_MODE               Read Update Mode (IF_SRM="DB_UPDATE...)                     .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_ACTIVITY                  Sets activity                                               .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_ACTIVITY_STATE            Sets completion status of activity                          .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_DEST_POID                 Sets Dest POID                                              .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_PARAMETER                 Sets a Parameter                                            .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_REQUEST_ID                Sets Request ID                                             .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_RESULT                    Sets result                                                 .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_RESULT_IS_VISIBLE         Set 'result is visible' flag                                .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_SOURCE_POID               Sets Source POID                                            .
IF_SRM_REQUEST                 I SET_UPDATE_MODE               Sets Update Mode (IF_SRM="DB_UPDATE...)                     .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I GET_REQUEST_TYPE              Determines Type of Activity                                 .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_INFO                  Processing Generic Activity: Info Dialog                    .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_INPLACE_ACTV          Processing an Inplace Activity                              .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_INPLACE_PASV          Processing an Inplace Activity                              .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_NEWMODE               Execute in new session                                      .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_NONVISUAL_ACTV        Invisible Activity (no visibility or just popup)            .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_NONVISUAL_PASV        Invisible Activity (no visibility or just popup)            .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_OUTPLACE              Outplace Activity                                           .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_QUERY                 Visual Search                                               .
IF_SRM_REQUEST_PROCESSOR       I PROCESS_WDA                   Processing of Generic Activity: ABAP Web Dynpro             .
IF_SRM_RG_PLACEHOLD_SUPPORT    I GET_DISPLAY_STRING            Get Display String                                          .
IF_SRM_RG_PLACEHOLD_SUPPORT    I IS_PLACE_HOLDER_ACTIVE        'Use Placeholder' activated?                                .
IF_SRM_RG_PLACEHOLD_SUPPORT    I MATCH_COUNTER_VALUE           Matches Context Counter Value                               .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I CONNECT_SRM_OBJECT_BY_ROLE    Connect: Create & Init & Buffer SRM Object for Class Role   .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_POID_BUFFER               Get: Interface Reference to POID Buffer                     .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_SPS_EXECUTION_BY_ID       Get: Interfaces Reference to SPS Execution                  .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_SPS_EXECUTION_BY_POID     Get: Interfaces Reference to SPS Execution                  .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_SPS_FACTORY_BY_ID         Get: Interfaces Reference to SPS Factory                    .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_SPS_FACTORY_BY_POID       Get: Interfaces Reference to SPS Factory                    .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I GET_SRM_OBJECT_BY_ROLE        Get: Create & Init SRM Object for Class Role                .
IF_SRM_ROOT                    I IS_POID_BUFFER_ACTIV          Check Whether POID Buffer Active                            .
IF_SRM_ROOT_BUFFER             I GET_CLASS_REGISTRY_BUFFER     Get:  Read Class Registry Buffer                            .
IF_SRM_ROOT_BUFFER             I SET_CLASS_REGISTRY_BUFFER     Set: Set Class Registry Buffer                              .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I CREATE_GUID                   Generates GUID                                              .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I GET_CLASS_FOR_CLIENT_FRAMEWORKGet: Class for Class Role for Client Framework              .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I GET_POID_HASH_STRING          Get: String for Forming Hash Value                          .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I GET_SPS_ID_CLIENT_FRAMEWORK   Get: SPS ID of CLient Framework                             .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I GET_UPDATE_MODE_POID_DIRECTORYGet: Update Mode for POID Directory                         .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Root Object                               .
IF_SRM_ROOT_HELPER             I SET_UPDATE_MODE_POID          Set: Update Mode for POID Directory                         .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I GET_DEFAULT_GUI_STATUS        Gets Standard GUI Status                                    .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I ON_EXIT                       Called when Exiting Client Framework                        .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I ON_INITIALIZATION             Call when Starting Client Framework                         .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I ON_NAVIGATION_END             Call Time: BACK to First Element                            .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I ON_PROCESS_FCODE              Call in FCODE Processing                                    .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I ON_SET_SPLITTER_WIDTH         Call When Splitter Switched                                 .
IF_SRM_SAPGUI_CFW_EXTENSION    I SETUP_WELCOME_SCREEN          Generate Welcome Screen                                     .
IF_SRM_SIMPLE_TREE             I ADD_ITEMS                     ADD_ITEMS                                                   .
IF_SRM_SIMPLE_TREE             I ADD_NODE                      ADD_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_SIMPLE_TREE             I ADD_TABS_2_TREE               ADD_TABS_2_TREE                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_API_CONTEXT          I SET_ACTIVEONLY                SET_ACTIVEONLY                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_API_CONTEXT          I SET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS         SET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS                                       .
IF_SRM_SK_API_CONTEXT          I SET_SETONLY                   SET_SETONLY                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I APPEND_REQUEST_TAB            APPEND_REQUEST_TAB                                          .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I CONNECT                       CONNECT                                                     .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I CONNECT_POID                  CONNECT_POID                                                .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I CREATE_XMLDOM                 CREATE_XMLDOM                                               .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_CONTENT                   GET_CONTENT                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_CURRENT_NODE_GID          GET_CURRENT_NODE_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               GET_DESCRIPTION                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_LOG_VERSION_ID            GET_LOG_VERSION_ID                                          .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_NODE                      GET_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_NODE_ATTRIBUTES           GET_NODE_ATTRIBUTES                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_OPEN_ASYNC                GET_OPEN_ASYNC                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_POID                      GET_POID                                                    .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_REQUEST                   GET_REQUEST                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_SEMANTIC_ID               GET_SEMANTIC_ID                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_SPS                       GET_SPS                                                     .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_STATE_OBJECT              GET_STATE_OBJECT                                            .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_TREE                      GET_TREE                                                    .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_VARIANT                   GET_VARIANT                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I GET_XMLDOM                    GET_XMLDOM                                                  .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I PARSE                         PARSE                                                       .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I RENDER                        RENDER                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I SET_CONTENT                   SET_CONTENT                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I SET_CURRENT_NODE_GID          SET_CURRENT_NODE_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I SET_OPEN_ASYNC                SET_OPEN_ASYNC                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_BSP                  I STORE                         STORE                                                       .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I CLEAR_PROPERTIES              CLEAR_PROPERTIES                                            .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I FLUSH_PROPERTIES              FLUSH_PROPERTIES                                            .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I GET_SEMANTIC_ID               GET_SEMANTIC_ID                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I GET_STATE                     GET_STATE                                                   .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I INIT_PROPERTIES               INIT_PROPERTIES                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I MAINTAIN_PROPERTIES           MAINTAIN_PROPERTIES                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_DOC                  I OBLIGAT_PROPERTIES            OBLIGAT_PROPERTIES                                          .
IF_SRM_SK_FRAMEWK              I COMPLETE_ASYNC                COMPLETE_ASYNC                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_FRAMEWK              I GET_EVENT_OBJECT              GET_EVENT_OBJECT                                            .
IF_SRM_SK_FRAMEWK              I SET_STATE                     SET_STATE                                                   .
IF_SRM_SK_FRAMEWK              I START_ACTIVITY                START_ACTIVITY                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_FRAMEWK              I START_QUERY                   START_QUERY                                                 .
IF_SRM_SK_FRONTEND_SAPGUI      I ANSWER_ON_EVENT               Callback for Messages from Called SP                        .
IF_SRM_SK_FRONTEND_SAPGUI      I MY_ACTION                     Executing Activities                                        .
IF_SRM_SK_FRONTEND_SAPGUI      I OPEN                          Initialization of Visualization Object                      .
IF_SRM_SK_FRONTEND_SAPGUI      I SYSTEM_INFO                   Processing CFW System Messages                              .
IF_SRM_SK_GOS                  I PUBLISH                       PUBLISH                                                     .
IF_SRM_SK_GOS                  I UNPUBLISH                     UNPUBLISH                                                   .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I CANCEL                        CANCEL                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I DELETE                        DELETE                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I GET_ACTIVITY                  GET_ACTIVITY                                                .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I RELOAD                        RELOAD                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I SAVE                          SAVE                                                        .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I TOGGLE                        TOGGLE                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_INSTANCE             I TOGGLE_INTERNAL               TOGGLE_INTERNAL                                             .
IF_SRM_SK_POPUP_SUPPRESS       I DELETE                        Confirmation Prompt Before Deletion                         .
IF_SRM_SK_RELATION             I EXTERNAL_MASTER_POID_GET      EXTERNAL_MASTER_POID_GET                                    .
IF_SRM_SK_REQUEST              I SET                           SET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_STATE                I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_STATE                I SET                           SET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_ALL                       ADD_ALL                                                     .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_NODE_FUNCTIONS            ADD_NODE_FUNCTIONS                                          .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_OTHER                     ADD_OTHER                                                   .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_PROPERTIES                ADD_PROPERTIES                                              .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_SAVE                      ADD_SAVE                                                    .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_SEPARATOR                 ADD_SEPARATOR                                               .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ADD_TOGGLE                    ADD_TOGGLE                                                  .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I CREATE                        CREATE                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_ALL            ENABLE_DISABLE_ALL                                          .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_NODE_FUNCTIONS ENABLE_DISABLE_NODE_FUNCTIONS                               .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_OTHER          ENABLE_DISABLE_OTHER                                        .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_PROPERTIES     ENABLE_DISABLE_PROPERTIES                                   .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_SAVE           ENABLE_DISABLE_SAVE                                         .
IF_SRM_SK_TOOLBAR              I ENABLE_DISABLE_TOGGLE         ENABLE_DISABLE_TOGGLE                                       .
IF_SRM_SK_TRANSACTION          I CHECK                         CHECK                                                       .
IF_SRM_SK_TRANSACTION          I COMMIT                        COMMIT                                                      .
IF_SRM_SK_TRANSACTION          I ROLLBACK                      ROLLBACK                                                    .
IF_SRM_SPS_EXECUTION           I SRM_CONNECTION                Class Role Execution: IS_SP_CONTENT_CONNECTION_CLASS        .
IF_SRM_SPS_EXECUTION           I SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO           Class Role Execution: IS_SP_NON_VISUAL_INFO_CLASS           .
IF_SRM_SPS_EXECUTION           I SRM_SP_SYSTEM_PARA            Class Role Execution: IS_SP_SYSTEM_CLASS                    .
IF_SRM_SPS_FACTORY             I CONNECT_OBJECT                Connect: SPS Object for POID and Class Role                 .
IF_SRM_SPS_FACTORY             I GET_OBJECT                    Get: SPS Object for POID and Class Role                     .
IF_SRM_SPS_REDEFINER           I CONNECTION                    Redefined Connection Parameter Values                       .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_AREA_CLASSI_PARA_VALUE    Get: AREA  Classification PARA Value for SPS and Para ID    .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_AREA_CLASSI_PARA_VALUES   Get: List of all AREA  Classification PARA Values for SPS   .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_AREA_ID                   Returns AREA ID of Element Type                             .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_CONNECTION_VALUES         Get: List of Attribute Value Objects for Connection Paramete.
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get: Display Name                                           .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_ID                        Returns Element Type ID of Element Type                     .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_SAP_ICONS                 Get: SAP Icons                                              .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_SP_ID                     Returns SP ID of Element Type                               .
IF_SRM_SPS_REGISTRY            I GET_SP_REGISTRY               Returns SP Registry Object to SPS                           .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I AREA_ID_GET                   Current Area ID                                             .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I AREA_ID_SET                   Current Area ID                                             .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I CLASSIFICATION_PARA_GET       SPS Classification Parameters                               .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I CLASSIFICATION_PARA_SET       SPS Classification Parameters                               .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I COMPLETENESS_CHECK            All Mandatory Attributes "" Initial?                        .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I CONNECTION_PARA_GET           SPS Connection Parameters                                   .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I CONNECTION_PARA_SET           SPS Connection Parameters                                   .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I DISPLAYNAME_GET               SPS Display Name                                            .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I DISPLAYNAME_SET               SPS Display Name                                            .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I ID_GET                        Element Type id                                             .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I ID_SET                        Element Type id                                             .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I LANGUAGE_GET                  Language for SPS Display Name (Optional, Default: sy-langu) .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I LANGUAGE_SET                  Language for SPS Display Name (Optional, Default: sy-langu) .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I SP_ID_GET                     Current SP ID                                               .
IF_SRM_SPS_REG_NEW             I SP_ID_SET                     Current SP ID                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_ACTIVITIES           I GET_INSTANCE_ACTIVITIES       Get: Instance Activities                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_ACTIVITIES           I GET_MODEL_ACTIVITIES          Get: Model Activities                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_AUTHORIZATION        I CHECK_ACTIVITY_AUTHORIZATION  Authorization Check for Activity                            .
IF_SRM_SP_AUTHORIZATION        I CHECK_VIEW_AUTHORIZATION      Check Display Authorization                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I CHECK_IN                      Upload Document as New Version, Release Lock                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I CHECK_OUT                     Download Document with Lock                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I CREATE_NEW_DOC                Create new document                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I DELETE_DOC                    Delete corresponding doc                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I DISPLAY_DOC                   Display corresponding object                                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I DISPLAY_DOC_VIA_FILE          ***not used*** Display document using filename              .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I DOWNLOAD_DOC                  Download Document                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I GET_GUI_OS_TYPE               Get Operating System Type of SAPGUI                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I GET_UPDATE_MODE               Determine Update Mode                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I MODIFY_DOC                    Modify DOI document                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I SET_FUNCTION_LIST             Set list of functions                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV                  I UPLOAD_DOC                    Upload Document (as new version)                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I CHECK_DOC_STATE_INFO          Get Status Info.:  Completed, Checked Out?                  .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I CLEAR_GSP_CACHE               Discard GSP Attribute Cache                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I GET_FUNCTION_GET_FORM_DATA    Get Connection Parameter 'FUNCTION_GET_FORM_DATA'           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I GET_MS_OFFICE_META_FROM_FILE  Get Specific MS Word Metadata from Uplaoded File            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I GET_MS_OFFICE_META_FROM_PROXY Get Specific MS Word Metadata from DOI Proxy                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I INIT_ATTRIBUTES               Initialization of Attributes When Creating Document         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I LEAVE_SAVED                   Flush Property Cache if Document is Saved Before Exit       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_ATTRIBUTE        I LEAVE_UNSAVED                 Unreserve Reference Object if Document not Saved Before Exit.
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_COMP             I DISPLAY_SELECTED_COMP         Display of Selected Components                              .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_COMP             I GET_COMP_GRID                 Get ALV Grid Control to Display Component List              .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_COMP             I SHOW_COMP_LIST                Display Component List                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I CALL_OWN_APPLICATION          Calls Subclass-Defined Visualization Method                 .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I CONFIRM_PUT                   Confirm after put                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I COPY_CONTENT_FROM_TEMPLATE    Clone document template                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I DELETE_CONTENT                Delete document content                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_CONTENT_FILE_INFORMATION  get information about the file(s) containing the content    .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_CONTENT_VIA_FILE          Get Document content using Filename                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_DOCUMENT_SP_TYPE          Get SP type: document, ArchiveLink doc or docum. template   .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_FORM_DATA                 get metadata (attribs) to be provided as DOI form-parameters.
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_MIMETYPE                  Get Mimetype of the object                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_URL_FOR_GET               Get URL for display                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I GET_URL_FOR_PUT               Get URL for storing a document                              .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I LOCK_CONTENT                  Lock the content of the document                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I RELOCK_CONTENT                Relock the content of the document                          .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_CONTENT          I SET_CONTENT_VIA_FILE          Set Document content using Filename                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_EAI              I DELETE_EAI_MARKUP_LAYER       Delete selected markup layer in ECL 2D/3D Viewer            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_EAI              I GET_EAI_MARKUP_TAB            Get EAI markup layer list                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_EAI              I SAVE_EAI_MARKUP_LAYER         Save user markup in ECL 2D/3D Viewer                        .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_HTML             I DISPLAY_DOC_FOR_HTML          Display Document using HTML GUI                             .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I BEGIN_ACTIVITY_BACKEND        Selects the start of backend access to an activity          .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I END_ACTIVITY_BACKEND          Selects the end of backend access to an activity            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_ACTIVITY_AUTHORIZATION    Authorization Check for Activity                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_ACTIVITY_CLIENT_WIDTH     Gets Width for Activity                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_INSTANCE_ACTIVITIES       Gets Instance Activities                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_MODEL_ACTIVITIES          Gets Model Activities                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_SPECIAL_FUNCTION_LIST     Get list of all special functions for the component         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I GET_VIEW_AUTHORIZATION        Authorization Check for List Display                        .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_SPECIAL          I SET_SPECIAL_FUNCTION          Do the selected special function                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_TEMPLATE         I GET_LIST                      Get Template List                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_TEMPLATE         I SHOW_LIST                     Display Templates                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_VERSION          I DISPLAY_SPECIAL_VERSION       Display the selected version                                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_VERSION          I GET_VERSION_GRID              Get the version grid cntl                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_VERSION          I GET_VERSION_LIST              Get the current version list                                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CANCEL_EDIT_DOI_DOC           Cancel editting DOI document                                .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CANCEL_EDIT_TEXT_DOC          Cancel editting in text editor                              .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CHECK_ACTIVITY_INPLACE        Checks whether current MIME type can be edited inplace      .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CREATE_DOC_FROM_TEMPLATE      Create new DOI document from template                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CREATE_NEW_DOC_VIA_DOI        Create new document using DOI                               .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CREATE_NEW_DOC_VIA_FILE       Create new document using Fileselection                     .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I CREATE_NEW_DOC_VIA_TEXTEDIT   Create new document via text editor                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_DOI_DOC               Display document using DOI                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_EAI2D_DOC             Display 2D - document using EAI                             .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_EAI3D_DOC             Display 3D - document using EAI                             .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_HTML_DOC              Display document using HTML                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_TEXT_DOC              display document via text editor                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DISPLAY_UNSUPPORTED_DOC       Displays an unsupported document type (static HTML message) .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I DOWNLOAD_DOC                  Download Document                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I MODIFY_DOI_DOC                Modify DOI document                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I MODIFY_TEXT_DOC               Modify txt document                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I SAVE_MODIFIED_DOI_DOC         Save modified DOI document                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I SAVE_NEW_DOI_DOC              Save new DOI document                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I SAVE_TEXT_DOC                 Save new text document                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I START_NEW_DOI_APP             Start DOI application                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_BDV_WIN              I UPLOAD_DOC                    Upload Document (as new version)                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER       I ON_DESTROY                    Is called when the request is cancelled (eg. Browser Back)  .
IF_SRM_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER       I ON_NEW_REQUEST                Called when New Request Executed                            .
IF_SRM_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER       I ON_REFRESH                    Called by Browser Back in Target SP                         .
IF_SRM_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER       I ON_REQUEST_ANSWER             Called when Request Executed                                .
IF_SRM_SP_BSP_CONTROLLER       I ON_USER_EVENT                 Called when User Triggers Event                             .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_BSP           I GET_BSP_APPLICATION           Returns Names of BSP Applications                           .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_OBJ           I GET_CONTENT_CONNECTION_OBJECT Returns Content Connection Object                           .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_OBJ           I GET_VISUALIZATION_STATE_OBJECTReturns Visualization State Object                          .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_OUTPLACE      I START_APPLICATION             Start SP Client Application Outplace                        .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I ANSWER_ON_EVENT               Callback for Messages from Called SP                        .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I GET_CLIENT_WIDTH              Returns Required Width for Activity                         .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I GET_EVENT_OBJECT              Gets Event Object                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I MY_ACTION                     Executing Activities                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I OPEN                          Initialization of Visualization Object                      .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I SET_EVENT_OBJECT              Sets Event Object                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_CLIENT_WIN           I SYSTEM_INFO                   Processing CFW System Messages                              .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENTS_GET    I GET_ELEMENTS                  Find Elements                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENTS_GET    I HAS_ELEMENTS                  Container Has Elements                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I ADD_ELEMENT_BY_PARENT         Insert an Element to a Parent Element as a Child            .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I ADD_ELEMENT_BY_REFERENCE      Add an Element Using a Reference Element                    .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I CLOSE                         Closes the Container                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete an Element                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I GET_FREE_CHILDREN_ELEMENTS    Free Child Elements (Record Model Structure, Cardinality)   .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I GET_MESSAGE                   Existing Message after Operation                            .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I IS_ADDING_OF_ELEMS_SUPPORTED  Does the container support addition of elements?            .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I IS_DELETING_OF_ELEMS_SUPPORTEDDoes the container support deletion of elements?            .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I OPEN                          Opens the Container for Changes                             .
IF_SRM_SP_CONT_ELEMENT_CHANGE  I SAVE                          Saves the Changes                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I CLEAR_GSP_CACHE               Discard GSP Buffering                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I CLOSE                         Close Document                                              .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I CONFIRM_PUT                   Confirm URL Transfer to Backend                             .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I CREATE                        Create New Document                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I DELETE                        Delete Document                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get Attributes of the Document                              .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_CONTENT_FILE_INFO         Get Content File Information                                .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_CONTENT_VIA_FILE          Pass Content to Frontend                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_CONTENT_VIA_TAB           Get Document Content via Table                              .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_URL_FOR_GET               Get URLs for Read Access to Document                        .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_URL_FOR_PUT               Get URLs for Writing Document                               .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_VERSION_LIST              Get Version List                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I GET_VERSION_LIST2             Get Version List (for Conversion to GSP 2)                  .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I OPEN                          Open Document to Display/Change                             .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I RETRIEVE_VERSION              Return this non-current version for the current version     .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Document Attributes                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I SET_CONTENT_VIA_FILE          Pass Content to Backend                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I SET_CONTENT_VIA_TAB           Set Content via Table                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_DOCUMENT             I UPDATE_STATE_CLOSED           SP Acvtivity: Close/Open Document                           .
IF_SRM_SP_ENQUEUE              I DEQUEUE                       Unlock object                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_ENQUEUE              I ENQUEUE                       Lock Element                                                .
IF_SRM_SP_EXCHANGE             I GET_CONTENT_CONNECTION_OBJECT Returns Content Connection Object                           .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I ANSWER_ON_EVENT               Callback for Messages from Called SP                        .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I FINISH_ASYNC                  End an Asynchronous Activity                                .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I GET_EVENT_OBJECT              Gets Event Object                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I GET_REQUEST_VISIBILITY        Query Whether Request is Visible Inplace                    .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I MY_ACTION                     Executing Activities                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I OPEN                          Initialization of Visualization Object                      .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I SET_EVENT_OBJECT              Sets Event Object                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_FRONTEND_SAPGUI_PASV I SYSTEM_INFO                   Processing CFW System Messages                              .
IF_SRM_SP_GOS                  I BOR_IDENT_GET                 Get BOR IF for GOS Publishing                               .
IF_SRM_SP_HRPA_BACKEND         I APP_LOG_WRITE                 Write an Entry in the Application Log                       .
IF_SRM_SP_HRPA_BACKEND         I GET_CONNECTION_PARAS          Returning Connection Parameters                             .
IF_SRM_SP_HRPA_BACKEND         I GET_CONTEXT_PARAS             Returning Content Parameters                                .
IF_SRM_SP_HRPA_BACKEND         I GET_RECORD_PROP_PERNO         Get Record Property for Personnel Number                    .
IF_SRM_SP_HRPA_BACKEND         I GET_SPPOID_PARAS              Select SP POID Parameters                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_INFO                 I SEMANTIC_TYPE_GET             Constant IF_SRM_NON_VISUAL_INFO_SP="C_SEMANTIC_*            .
IF_SRM_SP_MENUE                I GET_MENUE                     (Old - do not use)                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_MENUE                I GET_PROGNAME                  Gets Program Names for Status and Title                     .
IF_SRM_SP_MENUE                I GET_STATUS                    Gets Status of SP Client Component                          .
IF_SRM_SP_MENUE                I GET_TITLE                     Gets Title of the SP Client Component                       .
IF_SRM_SP_MENUE                I SEND_MENUE_OK_CODE            Processing SP-Defined OK Codes                              .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I CLOSE                         Unlock Record Model, Release Memory...                      .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I CREATE                        Create Record Model                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I ELEMENT_GET_ALL               Get All Nodes                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I ELEMENT_GET_BY_ID             Get Node from ID                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I ELEMENT_GET_DIRECT_CHILDS     Get All Child Nodes                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I FIRST_ID_GET_BY_ANCHOR        1. Find ID for Anchor                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I OPEN                          Load Record Model, Parse...                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I RELEASE                       Set Status of Record Model to 'Release'                     .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I SAVE                          Save Record Model (No Commit)                               .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL                I STATE_GET                     Find Status of the Record Model                             .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_CONTEXT        I ACTIVE_ONLY_SET               Read active nodes only?                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_CONTEXT        I IN_UPDATE_TASK_SET            Activate/Deactivate Update                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I EXPIRY_GET                    Currently Only C_EXPIRY_UNLIMITED                           .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I FREE_ATTRIBUTES_GET           Among Others C_ANCHOR_NAME                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I HAS_CHILDREN_GET              Has Child Elements                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I LAST_MODIFICATION_GET         YYYY-MM-DD and HH:MM:SS                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I LEVEL_GET                     Return Level of the Element in the Record Model             .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I LEVEL_SET                     Set Level of the Element in the Record Model                .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I PARENT_GET                    Get Parent Element                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I PARENT_SET                    Set Parent Element                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I STATE_GET                     C_STATE_INIT or C_STATE_SET or C_STATE_FOLDER               .
IF_SRM_SP_MODEL_ELEMENT        I TYPE_GET                      Return Types                                                .
IF_SRM_SP_OBJECT               I GET_POID                      Read POID Object                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QUERY     I PARTICIPATE                   Supports Cross-SP Search (Such as Aliasing)                 .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_CTL    I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_DEF    I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_DEF    I RAW_GET                       RAW_GET (List of Authorization Objects)                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_LDEF   I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_QDEF   I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_QUERY  I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_QUERY  I GET_SPS_REPOSITORY            GET_SPS_REPOSITORY                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CROSS_QY_VIS    I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_ASYNC       I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_ASYNC       I FLUSH                         FLUSH                                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_ASYNC       I INPLACE_CHECK                 INPLACE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_ASYNC       I PROPERTY_TAB_GET              PROPERTY_TAB_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_ASYNC       I RELEASE                       RELEASE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_QUERY       I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_CTL_SYNC        I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_HELP            I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_PRINT           I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_PRINT           I EXECUTE_BARCODE               EXECUTE_BARCODE                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_QUERY_DEFINE    I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_QUERY_VIS       I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOSITORY      I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOSITORY      I LOCK                          LOCK                                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOSITORY      I QUERY                         QUERY                                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOSITORY      I QUERY_RESULT_DETAIL_GET       QUERY_RESULT_DETAIL_GET                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOSITORY      I UNLOCK                        UNLOCK                                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_CONN      I SPS_PARTICIPATION             SPS_PARTICIPATION                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_DATA      I DELETE                        DELETE                                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_DATA      I EXISTENCE_CHECK               EXISTENCE_CHECK                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_DATA      I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_DATA      I SET                           SET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_KEY       I GUID_BY_OWN_POID_GET          GUID_BY_OWN_POID_GET                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_KEY       I POID_BY_GUID_GET              POID_BY_GUID_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_META      I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_META      I RAW_GET                       RAW_GET (List of Authorization Objects)                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_REPOS_META      I SINGLE_GET                    SINGLE_GET                                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I CHECK_IS_INITIAL              CHECK_IS_INITIAL                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I CONVERSION_IN                 CONVERSION_IN                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I CONVERSION_OUT                CONVERSION_OUT                                              .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I EXECUTE_BUTTON_CLICK          EXECUTE_BUTTON_CLICK                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I EXECUTE_CHECK                 EXECUTE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I EXECUTE_GENERATE              EXECUTE_GENERATE                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I EXECUTE_HELP                  EXECUTE_HELP                                                .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I GET_DROPDOWN_VALUES           Gets Values for Dropdown Display                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VALUE           I GET_TEXT                      Gets Text for Attribute Value                               .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VISUALIZATION   I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VISUALIZATION   I INPLACE_CHECK                 INPLACE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VISUALIZATION   I INPLACE_OK                    INPLACE_OK                                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VIS_DEFINE      I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROP_VIS_LIST_DEF    I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I CONVERT_OUTPUT                Convert Argument for Display Text                           .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I DELETE                        Use POID_ID to delete entry and more key fields (optional)  .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I DELETE_EXPIRY                 Delete All Expired Log Entries                              .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I INVALIDATE_DELAYED            Do Not Write Log Entries and Delete Buffer                  .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I READ                          Read Log Entries                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I WRITE                         Write a Log Entry                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_ENTRY       I WRITE_DELAYED                 Write Buffered Log Entries                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_META        I GET_ACT_DESC                  Get protocol description for an operation                   .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_META        I GET_SPECIAL_ACT_LIST          Get protocol description list of SP special operations      .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_META        I GET_STANDARD_ACT_LIST         Get protocol description list of standard operations        .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_VIEWER      I DISPLAY                       Display Log Relating to POID                                .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_VIEWER      I DISPLAY_SUBPROTO              Display SubLog Relating to a Log Entry                      .
IF_SRM_SP_PROTOCOL_VIEWER      I IS_SUBPROTO_DISPLAY_ENABLED   Detect Display Mode of SubLog in Reference to Subobject     .
IF_SRM_SP_QUERY_BSP            I GET_BSP_APPLICATION           Returns Names of BSP Applications                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I CLOSE                         Unlock Record, Release Memory, And So On                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I CREATE                        Create Record                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I DELETE                        Delete Record                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_ALL_ANCHORS    Inserts the element in all anchors with the same name       .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_ANCHOR         Insert Element in Record (Anchor)                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_MODELID        Insert Element in Record (modelid)                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_PARENT_ANCHOR  Insert Element in Record (Parent Node in Record, Anchor)    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_PARENT_MODELID Insert Element in Record (Parent Node in Record, Model ID)  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_BY_REFERENCE      Insert Element in Record (Using Reference ID)               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ADD_FIRST_FIT         Insert Element in Record (Implicit Using spsId)             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ATTRIBUTES_UPDATE     Change Element in File (Attributes Only)                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_CREATE                Factory: Create Element, Afterwards element_add and so on.  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_DELETE_BY_ID          Delete Element and Subnode (Unique ID)                      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_DELETE_BY_POID        Delete (All) Elements for a poid                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_DESCR_UPDATE          Change Element in Record (Description Only)                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_GET_ALL               Read All Elements                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_GET_BY_ID             Read Element (Unique ID)                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_GET_BY_MODELID        Read Element(s) (Non-Unique modelid)                        .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_GET_BY_TYPE           Read all Elements for a Specific Type                       .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_RELATIONS_UPDATE      Change Element in Record (Relations Only)                   .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ELEMENT_ROLES_UPDATE          Change Element in Record (Roles Only [Visibility])          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I FREEZE_RECORD                 Freeze/Close Record                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I GET_RECORD_HEADER             Returns Header Information about the Record                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I GET_RECORD_PROTOCOL           Gets Log of Record                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I IS_RECORD_FROZEN              Determines Whether Record Closed                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I ITERATOR_CREATE               Factory: Create Iterator for Tree Version                   .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I OPEN                          Load/Parse xml Record (If Necessary, Also xml Record Model) .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I SAVE                          Save Record (No Commit Takes Place)                         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD               I UNFREEZE_RECORD               Open Record                                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_CONTEXT       I ACCESS_CHECK_SET              Activate/Deactivate Access Check                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_CONTEXT       I IN_UPDATE_TASK_SET            Activate/Deactivate Update                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_CONTEXT       I RELATION_MASTER_SET           Overwrite the Master POID (Relation)                        .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I ATTRIBUTES_GET                Standard Attributes (Const ATTRIBUTE_*) and Free Attributes .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I ATTRIBUTES_SET                Standard Attributes (Const ATTRIBUTE_*) and Free Attributes .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I DESCRIPTION_GET               Description Text                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I DESCRIPTION_SET               Description Text                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I HAS_CHILDREN_GET              Does a Child Node Exist?                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I HAS_CHILDREN_SET              Does a Child Node Exist?                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I LAST_MODIFICATION_GET         Get Last Change                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I LAST_MODIFICATION_SET         Set Last Change                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I LEVEL_GET                     Get Level of Element in Record                              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I LEVEL_SET                     Set Level of Element in Record                              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I MODELID_GET                   Model ID (idref)                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I PARENT_GET                    Get Parent Element                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I PARENT_SET                    Set Parent Element                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I ROLES_GET                     Visibility (Volume of Roles)                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I ROLES_SET                     Visibility (Volume of Roles)                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I TYPE_GET                      Folder, Instance or Model                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEMENT       I TYPE_SET                      Folder, Instance or Model                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_CHECK    I CONSISTENCY                   CONSISTENCY                                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_EXPERT   I HAS_MODEL_CHILDREN_GET        Do model child nodes exist?                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_EXPERT   I HAS_MODEL_CHILDREN_SET        Set whether model child nodes exist                         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_INSTANCE I POID_GET                      Instance poid                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_INSTANCE I POID_SET                      Instance poid                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_INSTANCE I RELATIONS_GET                 Application Specific Relations (Volume of IDs)              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_INSTANCE I RELATIONS_SET                 Application Specific Relations (Volume of IDs)              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_MODEL    I RELATIONS_GET                 Application Specific Relations (Volume of IDs)              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_MODEL    I RELATIONS_SET                 Application Specific Relations (Volume of IDs)              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_MODEL    I SPS_ID_GET                    Find out Permitted SPS for the Node                         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_MODEL    I SPS_ID_SET                    Set Permitted SPS for the Node                              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_RUNTIME  I GID_GET                       ixml gid                                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_RUNTIME  I GID_SET                       ixml gid                                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_RUNTIME  I ID_GET                        ID                                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ELEM_RUNTIME  I ID_SET                        ID                                                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I CHECK_AUTH_RECSTRUCT          Check Authorization for Record Structure                    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I DARK_OPEN                     Open for using API with CL_SRM_REC-"MY_DARK_ACTION.         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I DELETE_NO_CHECK               Delete Record (without Checks, Internal Use)                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I DESCRIPTION_UPDATE            Change Description Text for Root Node                       .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I DOCID_GET                     Read Current Doc ID (KPro Only)                             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I DOCID_GET_AS_STRING           Return Current Doc ID as String                             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I ELEMENT_CHECK_CARDINALITY     Has the Maximum Number of Instance Nodes Been Reached?      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I ELEMENT_GET_BY_GID            Read Element (ixml-gid)                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I ELEMENT_POID_CHECK_EXISTENCE  poid Already Available in Record?                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I ELEMENT_SET_PROVIDE_ALL_ATTRS Provide element with all attributes (can eat up runtime)    .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I GET_DOCUMENT                  Get Document                                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I GET_MODEL_DOCUMENT            Return Model Document                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I INITIALIZE_MODEL_CACHE        Initialize Cache for Record Model                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I IS_RECORD_OPENED              Returns whether record is open                              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I LOCK                          Lock Record                                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I MODEL_POID_GET                Read POID of the Record Model (after ~OPEN!)                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I SET_FILTER_OUT_MODEL_NODES    Set Filtering out of Model Nodes                            .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I SET_LOCK_MODE                 Set Mode for Locking Record                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I SET_MODEL_CACHE               Activate/Deactivate Cache for Record Model                  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I SET_PROTOCOL_HANDLING         Write Specified Log Entries                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I UNLOCK                        Unlock Record                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I XML_INSTANCE_SET              Set XML-DOM Externally                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_EXPERT        I XML_MODEL_SET                 Set XML-DOM Externally                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_DESCRIPTION               Find Description of Record                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_DOC_ID                    Find out the Record ID                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_LAST_MODIF_DATE           Find out Date of Last Change                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_LAST_MODIF_TIME           Find out Time of Last Change                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_LAST_MODIF_USER           Find out Author of Last Change                              .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_STATUS                    Find out structure of the record (if available)             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I GET_VERSION                   Find out the Version of the Record                          .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_HEADER        I IS_FROZEN                     Returns whether the record is frozen                        .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ITERATOR      I DIRECT_CHILD_GET_FIRST        1. Read Direct Child Element                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ITERATOR      I DIRECT_CHILD_GET_NEXT         Read Additional Child Element                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ITERATOR      I ITERATOR_SET_BY_ELEMENT       Set Iterator to Element                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ITERATOR      I NEXT_ELEMENT_GET              Return Next Element                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_ITERATOR      I PREVIOUS_ELEMENT_GET          Return Previous Element                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_PRINT         I CLOSE_PRINT                   Complete Printout                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_PRINT         I EXECUTE_PRINT                 Print Record                                                .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_PRINT         I GET_SUPP_FUNCS_4_ELEMENT      Retrurns Supported Print Functions for Element (Type)       .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_PRINT         I PRINT_ELEMENT                 Print Element                                               .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_PRINT         I PRINT_RECORD                  Print Record Structure/Attributes/Log of Record             .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_SEARCH        I ELEMENT_SEARCH_BY_DESCR       Searches for Element Using the Description                  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_SEARCH        I ELEMENT_SEARCH_BY_DESCR_REGEX Searches for Element Using Description (Regular Expression) .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_WF_EVENT      I IS_WF_EVENT_TO_RAISE          Specifies Whether Workflow Event Triggered                  .
IF_SRM_SP_RECORD_WF_EVENT      I RAISE_WF_EVENT                Trigger Workflow Event                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_RECURSIVE_OPERATION  I EXECUTE                       Execution of Operation on SP                                .
IF_SRM_SP_REFERENCE            I GET_REFERENCE                 Get Unique Indicator                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ATTR_DESC_CONNECTION      Get: Attribute Description of Connection Parameters         .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ATTR_DESC_CONTEXT         Get: Attribute Description of Context Parameters            .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ATTR_DESC_SP_POID         Get: Attribute Description of SP POID Parameters            .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ATTR_DESC_VALUE_CHECK     Get: Attribute Description of all Value Check Attributes    .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ATTR_DESC_VALUE_HELP      Get: Attribute Description of all Value Help Attributes     .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_CLASS_ROLES               Get: Class Roles Filled by SP                               .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get: Display Name                                           .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_ID                        Get: SP ID                                                  .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_SAP_ICONS                 Get: SAP Icons                                              .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_SPS_REGISTRIES            Get: List of All SPS Registrys for SP                       .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_SP_TEMPLATE_ID            Get: SP ID of SP Template                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_REGISTRY             I GET_SP_TYPE_ID                Get: SP Type ID                                             .
IF_SRM_SP_SYSTEM_PARA          I GET_ATTR_DESC_CONNECTION      Returns Description of Connection Parameters                .
IF_SRM_SP_SYSTEM_PARA          I GET_ATTR_DESC_CONTEXT         Returns Description of Context Parameters                   .
IF_SRM_SP_SYSTEM_PARA          I GET_ATTR_DESC_SP_POID         Returns Description of SP POID Parameters                   .
IF_SRM_SP_TRANSIENT_UPDATE     I OPEN_FOR_UPDATE               Read Data from Repository                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_TRANSIENT_UPDATE     I WRITE_TO_REPOSITORY           Write into Repository                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_TUTORIAL_BACKEND     I GET_FLIGHT_DATA               Read Flight Date                                            .
IF_SRM_SP_TUTORIAL_BACKEND     I SET_SPPOID_PARA               Sets the SP POID Data                                       .
IF_SRM_SP_URL                  I CHECK_URL                     Check a URL for Invalid Characters                          .
IF_SRM_SP_URL                  I CREATE_URL                    Create: Model -" Instance                                   .
IF_SRM_SP_URL                  I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_SRM_SP_URL                  I GET_URL                       Read URL                                                    .
IF_SRM_SP_URL                  I SET_URL                       Set URL                                                     .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get: List of all Attributes, with Value Check               .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I GET_LIMIT_INSTANCE            Get: Check of Possible Values Restricted to Instance        .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I GET_LIMIT_SPS                 Get: Check of Possible Values Restricted to Element Type    .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I GET_UPDATE_VALUE_DESCRIPTION  Get: Flag for Changing Value Descriptions                   .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I GET_VALUES                    Get: List of Attribute Value Objects for Value Check        .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I SET_LIMIT_INSTANCE            Set: Check of Possible Values Restricted to Instance        .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I SET_LIMIT_SPS                 Set: Check of Possible Values Restricted to Element Type    .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I SET_UPDATE_VALUE_DESCRIPTION  Set: Flag for Changing Value Descriptions                   .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK          I SET_VALUES                    Get: List of Attribute Value Objects for Value Check        .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_CHECK_EXE      I EXECUTE_CHECK                 Execute Value Check                                         .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Get: Attribute Description for Which Input Help is Required .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get: List of all Attributes with Input Help                 .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_LIMIT_INSTANCE            Get: Selection of Possible Values Restricted to Instance    .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_LIMIT_SPS                 Get: Selection of Possible Values Restricted to Element Type.
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_SELECTION_MAX_NUMBER      Get: Maximum Number of Values to be Selected                .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I GET_SELECTION_MIN_NUMBER      Get: Minimum Number of Values to be Selected                .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Set: Attribute Description for Which Inout Help is Required .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I SET_LIMIT_INSTANCE            Set: Selection of Possible Values Restricted to Instance    .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I SET_LIMIT_SPS                 Set: Selection of Possible Values Restricted to SPS         .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I SET_SELECTION_MAX_NUMBER      Set: Maximum Number of Values to be Selected                .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP           I SET_SELECTION_MIN_NUMBER      Set: Minimum Number of Values to be Selected                .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP_EXE       I EXECUTE_HELP                  Executing Input Help                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_VALUE_HELP_WIN       I EXECUTE_SELECTION             Executing Input Help                                        .
IF_SRM_SP_VERSION              I INCREASE                      Raise Version Number by One                                 .
IF_SRM_SP_VISUAL_QUERY_WIN     I QUERY_SPS_SINGLE_RESULT       Element Type Specific Query                                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I CONVERT_POID_TO_STRING        Convert:  POID -" String                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I CONVERT_STRING_TO_POID        Convert: String -" POID                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_INSTANCE_POID             Get: Instance POID                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_MODEL_POID                Get: Model POID                                             .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_MY_SPS_ID                 Get: SPS ID for Client Framework                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_MY_SPS_REGISTRY           Get: SPS Registry Object for Client Framework               .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_POID_BUFFER               Get: POID Buffer                                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_MANAGER      I GET_SPS_FACTORY               Get: Interfaces to SPS Factory                              .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_OBJ_FACTORY  I CREATE_DRAGDROPDATA           Generated a DragDrop Data Object                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_OBJ_FACTORY  I CREATE_REQUEST                Generates a Request Object                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I AUTH_CHECK_ACTIVITY           Check Authorization for Activity                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I AUTH_CHECK_VIEW_BY_POID       Checks Whether Authorization Exists for Displaying POID     .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I AUTH_CHECK_VIEW_BY_RMSID      Checks Whether Authorization Exists for Displaying an RMS   .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I AUTH_CHECK_VIEW_BY_SPSID      Checks Whether Authorization Exists for Displaying a SPS    .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_CHECK_POID1_RELA    Checks Whether POID Relation for POID1 Exists               .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_CHECK_POID2_RELA    Checks Whether POID Relation for POID2 Exists               .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_DEL_POID            Deletes POID from Directory                                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_DEL_POID_RELA       Delete POID Relation                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_GET_POID            Gets POID from Directory                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_GET_POID1_RELA      Get POID Relation                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_GET_POID2_RELA      Get POID Relation                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_SET_POID            Sets POID in POID Directory                                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I DIRECTORY_SET_POID_RELA       Set POID Relation                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I GET_CUSTOM_SERVICE_MGR        Gets Custom Service Manager                                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_CHECK_ACTIVITY           Checks Whether Activity can be Executed (incl. AUTHORITY)   .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_CREATE_MODEL             Generates Model POID                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_GET_ACTIVITIES           Gets List of Possible Activities for a POID                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_GET_INSTANCE             Gets Instance POID                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_GET_RMS_ID               Gets RMS ID for POID                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I POID_GET_STANDARD_ACTIVITY    Gets Standard Activity for a POID                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I REGISTRY_CHECK_SPS_CLASSI_PARAChecks Whether a Classification Parameter Value Exists      .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I REGISTRY_GET_RMS_LIST         Gets List of all RMS (with authorization check)             .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I REGISTRY_GET_SPS_CLASSI_PARA  Gets Classification Parameter for SPS                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE      I REGISTRY_GET_SPS_LIST         Gets List of all SPS (with authorization check)             .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE_BSP  I REQUEST_GET_URL               Gets URL for a Request                                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE_WIN  I GET_NEW_DRAGDROPDATA          Gets New Framework Dragdrop DataObject                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE_WIN  I POID_GET_ACTIVITY_VISUAL_STATEGets Visualization Option for an Activity                   .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE_WIN  I POID_GET_MENU                 Gets a Context Menu with the Activities for a POID          .
IF_SRM_SRM_CLIENT_SERVICE_WIN  I START_REQUEST_IN_NEW_MODE     Starts a Request in a New Session                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ACTIVITY_LIST          Creates Activity List Object                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_ANY          Create Attribute Description Object for Any Attribute       .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_CONNECTION   Creates Attribute Description Object for SP Connection PARA .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_CONTEXT      Creates Attribute Description Object for SP Context PARA    .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_INFO         Creates Attribute Description Object for SP Info PARA       .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_PROPERTY     Creates Attribute Description Object for Properties         .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_DESC_SP_POID      Creates Attribute Description Object for SP POID PARA       .
IF_SRM_SRM_OBJECT_FACTORY      I CREATE_ATTR_VALUE             Creates Attribute Value Object for All Types of Attributes  .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QUERY    I PARTICIPATE                   Supports Cross-SP Search (Such as Aliasing)                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_CTL   I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_DEF   I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_DEF   I RAW_GET                       RAW_GET (List of Authorization Objects)                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_LDEF  I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_QDEF  I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_QUERY I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_QUERY I GET_SPS_REPOSITORY            GET_SPS_REPOSITORY                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CROSS_QY_VIS   I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_ASYNC      I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_ASYNC      I FLUSH                         FLUSH                                                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_ASYNC      I INPLACE_CHECK                 INPLACE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_ASYNC      I PROPERTY_TAB_GET              PROPERTY_TAB_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_ASYNC      I RELEASE                       RELEASE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_QUERY      I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_CTL_SYNC       I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_HELP           I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_PRINT          I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_PRINT          I EXECUTE_BARCODE               EXECUTE_BARCODE                                             .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_QUERY_DEFINE   I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_QUERY_VIS      I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I INTEGER_SINGLE_SET            INTEGER_SINGLE_SET                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I LOCK                          LOCK                                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I QUERY                         QUERY                                                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I QUERY_RESULT_DETAIL_GET       QUERY_RESULT_DETAIL_GET                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I SINGLE_GET                    SINGLE_GET                                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I STRING_SINGLE_SET             STRING_SINGLE_SET                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOSITORY     I UNLOCK                        UNLOCK                                                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_CONN     I SPS_PARTICIPATION             SPS_PARTICIPATION                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_DATA     I DELETE                        DELETE                                                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_DATA     I EXISTENCE_CHECK               EXISTENCE_CHECK                                             .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_DATA     I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_DATA     I SET                           SET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_KEY      I GUID_BY_OWN_POID_GET          GUID_BY_OWN_POID_GET                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_KEY      I POID_BY_GUID_GET              POID_BY_GUID_GET                                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_META     I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_META     I RAW_GET                       RAW_GET (List of Authorization Objects)                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_REPOS_META     I SINGLE_GET                    SINGLE_GET                                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I CHECK_IS_INITIAL              CHECK_IS_INITIAL                                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I CONVERSION_IN                 CONVERSION_IN                                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I CONVERSION_OUT                CONVERSION_OUT                                              .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I EXECUTE_BUTTON_CLICK          EXECUTE_BUTTON_CLICK                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I EXECUTE_CHECK                 EXECUTE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I EXECUTE_GENERATE              EXECUTE_GENERATE                                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I EXECUTE_HELP                  EXECUTE_HELP                                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I GET_DROPDOWN_VALUES           Gets Drop-Down Values                                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VALUE          I GET_TEXT                      Gets Text for Attribute Value                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VISUALIZATION  I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VISUALIZATION  I INPLACE_CHECK                 INPLACE_CHECK                                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VISUALIZATION  I INPLACE_OK                    INPLACE_OK                                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VIS_DEFINE     I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_PROP_VIS_LIST_DEF   I GET                           GET                                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_REGISTRY            I GET_CHECK_REGISTRY            Get: Interface Reference to Check Registry  Interface       .
IF_SRM_SRM_REGISTRY            I GET_EDIT_SPS                  Get Interface Reference for Editing SPS Interface           .
IF_SRM_SRM_REGISTRY            I GET_QUERY_AREA                Get: Interface Reference to Query AREA Interface            .
IF_SRM_SRM_REGISTRY            I GET_QUERY_SP                  Get: Interface Reference to Query SP Interface              .
IF_SRM_SRM_REGISTRY            I GET_QUERY_SPS                 Get: Interface Reference to Query SPS Interface             .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I CHECK_SP_CONNECTION           Check: POID and Other Parameters Using SP                   .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I CONNECT_CONTEXT               Connect: SP Context Value Objects (are buffered)            .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I CONVERT_POID_TO_STRING        Convert:  POID Object -" String                             .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I CONVERT_STRING_TO_POID        Convert: String -" POID                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I DEQUEUE_ELEMENT               Locks One Element                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I ENQUEUE_ELEMENT               Locks One Element                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_ACTIVITIES                Get: Activity List                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_ACTIVITY_PARAMS           Get: Parameter List for Activity                            .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_COMPARE                   Get: Compare Interface                                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_CROSS_QY_PROPERTY_SERVICE Get: Cross-Query Property Service                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Get: Display Name for POID                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_INFO                      Get: Info SP Object and POID                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_INSTANCE_POID             Get: Instance POID                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_MODEL_POID                Get: Model POID Object                                      .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_POID_DIRECTORY            Get: POID Directory Object                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_PROPERTY_SERVICE          Get: Property Service                                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_SAP_ICON_ID               Get: SAP ICON ID for POID (Model or Instance)               .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_SPS_CONN_ATTR_VALUES_UNBUFUNBUFFERED (!) GET                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_SP_CONNECTION             Retrieves CONNECTION Object for POID                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_SP_SEMANTIC_TYPE          Get: Semantic Type of SP                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_VALUE_CHECK               Get: Interface to Value Check                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_VALUE_HELP                Get: Interface to Input Help                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE             I GET_VISUAL_SERVICE_WINDOWS    Get: Interface to Visual Service for Windows                .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_ITABS_ITABS              Check if all ITABs of two POIDS are identical               .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_ITAB_ITAB                Check if specific ITABs of two POIDS are identical          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_OBJECT_ITABS             Check if POID object and POID ITABs are identical           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_OBJECT_OBJECT            Check if two POID objects are identical                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_OBJECT_STRING            Check if POID object and POID XML string are identical      .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_STRING_ITABS             Check if POID XML string and POID ITABs are identical       .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_COMPARE     I POID_STRING_STRING            Check it two POID XML strings are identical                 .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I COPY_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE          "Deep Copy" Attribute Value/Attribute Description Object    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_CONTEXT                   Get: Context ObjeCt                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_CTL_ASYNC                 Get: Asynchronous Control                                   .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_CTL_QUERY                 Get: Query Control                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_CTL_SYNC                  Get: Synchronous Control                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_HELP                      Get: Help Handler                                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_PRINT                     Get: Printer                                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_QUERY_DEFINE              Get: Query Definer                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_QUERY_VISUALIZATION       Get: Query Visualization                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_REPOSITORY                Get: Repository Handler                                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_VALUE                     Get: Value Handler                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_VISUALIZATION             Get: Visualization                                          .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP        I GET_VIS_DEFINE                Get: Visualization Definer                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_CONTEXT                   Get: Context ObjeCt                                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_CONTROL                   Get: Cross-SP Search / Control                              .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_DEFINE                    Get: Cross-SP Search / Metadata: General                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_LIST_DEFINE               Get: Cross-SP Search / Metadata: List Visualization         .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_QUERY                     Get: Cross-SP Search / Search Execution                     .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_QUERY_DEFINE              Get: Cross-SP Search / Metadata: Query Visualization        .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_SP_SUPPORT                Get: Cross-SP Search / SP-Specific Objects                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_PROP_CRQY   I GET_VISUALIZATION             Get: Cross-SP Search / Visualization                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_SHARE       I COPYPASTEDATA_CONNECT         COPYPASTEDATA_CONNECT                                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_SPS_REDEF   I CONNECTION_GET                Redefined Connection Parameter Values                       .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_SPS_REDEF   I CONNECTION_MERGE              Merge Connection Parameter Values from DB and Redefinition  .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I DISPLAY_INFO                  Display: Information                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I DISPLAY_TEXT                  Display: Any Text in POP UP Display                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I DISPLAY_WHEREUSED             Display: Where-Used List                                    .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I GET_ACTIVITIES_CTMENU         Get: Context Menu from Activities                           .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I GET_INFO                      Get: Interface to Information                               .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I GET_POID_BROWSER              Get: Interface to POID Browser                              .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I GET_REGISTRY_BROWSER          Get: Interface to Registry Registry                         .
IF_SRM_SRM_SERVICE_WINDOWS     I GET_VALUE_HELP                Get: Interface to Input Help                                .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_CHECK         I EXECUTE_CHECK                 Executing the Value Check                                   .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_CHECK         I GET_SETTINGS                  Get: Interface to Settings                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_HELP          I EXECUTE_HELP                  Executing Input Help                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_HELP          I GET_SETTINGS                  Get: Interface to Settings                                  .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_HELP_WIN      I EXECUTE_SELECTION             Executing Input Help                                        .
IF_SRM_SRM_VALUE_HELP_WIN      I GET_SETTINGS                  Get: Interface to Settings                                  .
IF_SRM_STACKED_CONTROL         I CHECK_ITEM                    Checks whether referenced element is contained in stack     .
IF_SRM_STACKED_CONTROL         I MOVE_TO_ITEM                  Makes a particular element from a stack visible             .
IF_SRM_STACKED_CONTROL         I UNLOAD_ALL                    Unload all SPs                                              .
IF_SRM_STACKED_CONTROL         I UNLOAD_ITEM                   Unloads an particular element                               .
IF_SRM_STATUS                  I CREATE                        Create Status                                               .
IF_SRM_STATUS                  I CREATE_EVENT                  Create Event                                                .
IF_SRM_STATUS                  I DELETE                        Delete Status                                               .
IF_SRM_STATUS                  I GET_PROPERTIES                Find Attributes                                             .
IF_SRM_STATUS                  I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I CHECK_STATUS_EXISTENCE        Check if status exists                                      .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I CREATE                        Make Entry in Status Network                                .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I DELETE                        Delete Entry in Status Network                              .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I DISPLAY_COMPLETE_STATUS_LIST  Display Valid Status                                        .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I DISPLAY_VALID_STATUS_LIST     Display Valid Status                                        .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I GET_COMPLETE_STATUS_LIST      Get Valid Status Values                                     .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I GET_STATUS_LIST               Get Status Network for Status Profile                       .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I GET_STATUS_OBJECT             Get Status Object                                           .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I GET_STATUS_PROFILE_OBJECT     Get Status Profile Object                                   .
IF_SRM_STATUS_NET              I GET_VALID_STATUS_LIST         Get Valid Status Values                                     .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I CREATE                        Create profile                                              .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I DELETE                        Delete Profile                                              .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I DISPLAY_PROFILE_LIST          Display and Select Profiles                                 .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I GET_INITIAL_STATUS            Find Initial Status                                         .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I GET_PROPERTIES                Find Attributes                                             .
IF_SRM_STATUS_PROFILE          I SET_PROPERTIES                Create Attributes                                           .
IF_SRM_TAB_TRANSFER            I GET_CONTENT                   Get Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_TAB_TRANSFER            I SET_CONTENT                   Set Content of Variant                                      .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I ADD_CONTAINER_NODE            Add Transparent Container                                   .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I ADD_ELEMENT_NODE              Add Element of the Transparent Container                    .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Node(s)                                              .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_CONTAINER_OF_ELEMENT      Return Container for an Element                             .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_CONTAINER_OF_ELEMENT_KEY  Return Container for an Element (Key)                       .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_ELEMENT_BY_ID             Finds Element Using the ID/Container                        .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_ELEMENT_OF_NODE           Returns Element for the Transparent Node                    .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_GUID_OF_CONTAINER         Find GUID for the Container                                 .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_NODE_KEY_OF_ELEMENT       Returns the Node ID for an Element                          .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_PARENT_KEY_OF_ELEMENT     Find Parent Nodes of the Element                            .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I GET_ROOT_CONTAINER            Find Root Container                                         .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_CONTAINER_RESOLVED         Has the container already been exploded?                    .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_NODE_4_ELEMENT_EXISTING    Checks whether a node exists for an element                 .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_NODE_CONTAINER             Checks whether a tree node is a transparent container       .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_NODE_TO_REPAINT            Does the node have to be drawn again?                       .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_NODE_TRANSPARENT           Checks whether a tree node is transparent                   .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I IS_PREV_NODE_POID_EXISTING    Does a node exist with the same POID as the element?        .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I SET_ALL_NODES_TO_REPAINT      All nodes have to be displayed again                        .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I SET_CONTAINER_RESOLVED        Declare Container Exploded                                  .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD      I SET_NODE_AS_REPAINTED         The node has been drawn again                               .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I CHECK_IF_CHG_SUPPORTED        Returns whether container supports changes                  .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I CLOSE_ALL_CONTAINERS          Close All Containers                                        .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I CLOSE_CONTAINER               Close Container                                             .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I GET_INTERFACE                 Interface for Making Changs to Containers                   .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I IS_A_CONTAINER_CHANGED        Checks whether at least one container has been changed      .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I IS_A_CONTAINER_OPENED         Checks whether at least one container is opened for changing.
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I IS_CONTAINER_OPENED           Checks whether a container has been opened for changing     .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I OPEN_CONTAINER                Open Container for Changes                                  .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I SAVE_ALL_CONTAINERS           Save All Open Containers                                    .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_CHG  I SET_CONTAINER_AS_CHANGED      Flag a Container as Changed                                 .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_ITER I GET_COLLECTION_FROM_BUFFER    Return Collection for Completed Nodes                       .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_ITER I GET_ITERATOR_4_CONTAINER      Return Iterator for Container                               .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_ITER I GET_ITERATOR_FROM_BUFFER      Return Iterator for Processed Nodes                         .
IF_SRM_TRANSPARENT_RECORD_ITER I SET_ITERATOR_POS_4_CONTAINER  Set Iterator Position for Container                         .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_CHILD_NODES               ADD_CHILD_NODES                                             .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_ITEMS                     ADD_ITEMS                                                   .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_NODE                      ADD_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_NODE_DUMMY                ADD_NODE_DUMMY                                              .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_ROOT                      ADD_ROOT                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I ADD_SINGLE_NODE               ADD_SINGLE_NODE                                             .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I COLLAPSE                      COLLAPSE                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I DELETE                        DELETE                                                      .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I DEL_NODE                      DEL_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I DEL_NODE_DUMMY                DEL_NODE_DUMMY                                              .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I EXPAND                        EXPAND                                                      .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_EXPANDED_NODES            get_expanded_nodes                                          .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_SELECTED                  GET_SELECTED                                                .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_TREE                      GET_TREE                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_TREE_SEMANTIC             GET_TREE_SEMANTIC                                           .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_TREE_TYPE                 GET_TREE_TYPE                                               .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I GET_XMLDOM                    GET_XMLDOM                                                  .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I MOVE_SINGLE_NODE              MOVE_SINGLE_NODE                                            .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I REBUILD                       REBUILD                                                     .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I RESTYLE                       RESTYLE                                                     .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SEARCH                        SEARCH                                                      .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SET_NODE_TABS                 set_node_tabs                                               .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SET_SELECTED                  SET_SELECTED                                                .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SUB_COPY                      SUB_COPY                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SUB_DESELECT                  SUB_DESELECT                                                .
IF_SRM_TREE                    I SUB_PASTE                     SUB_PASTE                                                   .
IF_SRM_TREE_ITEM               I SET_IMAGE                     SET_IMAGE                                                   .
IF_SRM_TREE_ITEM               I SET_STYLE                     SET_STYLE                                                   .
IF_SRM_TREE_ITEM               I SET_TEXT                      SET_TEXT                                                    .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I REFRESH_NODE                  Refresh nodes                                               .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_DRAGID                    SET_DRAGID                                                  .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_DRAG_DROPID_NATIVE        Set Drag & Drop ID Directly for a Node                      .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_DROPID                    Set Drop ID for a Node                                      .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_EXPANDER                  Set Expand Indicator                                        .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_EXP_IMAGE                 SET_EXP_IMAGE                                               .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_IMAGE                     SET_IMAGE                                                   .
IF_SRM_TREE_NODE               I SET_N_IMAGE                   SET_N_IMAGE                                                 .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I ADD_SINGLE_TRANSP_NODE        Add Transparent Node                                        .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I CONVERT_NODE_KEY_2_CTRL       Convert Node ID from String to Control Format               .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I DELETE_TRANSPARENT_NODE       Delete Transparent Node                                     .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I EXPAND_NODE_TABS              Expand Node (Set Using if_srm_tree~set_node_tabs)           .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I EXPAND_TRANSPARENT_CONT_STRUCTExpand Transparent Container Recursively                    .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I EXPAND_WITHOUT_TRANSP_NODES   Expand Nodes, without Transparent Nodes                     .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I GET_NODE_KEY_EXPANDED         Return Node ID of the Element to be Expanded                .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I INIT_SEARCH                   Initialize Search                                           .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I SET_REC_POID                  Sets record POID                                            .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I SET_TRANSPARENT_RECORD        Set Reference for Transparent Record                        .
IF_SRM_TREE_RECORD             I SET_TRANSP_CONTAINER_DISPL    Transparent Structure: Change to Display Mode               .
IF_SRM_URL_PROVIDER            I GET_URL                       Returns URL                                                 .
IF_SRM_URL_TRANSFER            I CONFIRM_PUT                   Transfer Data (After calling Get_url_for_Put)               .
IF_SRM_URL_TRANSFER            I GET_URL_FOR_GET               Get URL for Selecting Content                               .
IF_SRM_URL_TRANSFER            I GET_URL_FOR_PUT               Get URL for Writing Content                                 .
IF_SRM_VARIANT                 I DELETE                        Delete Variant                                              .
IF_SRM_VARIANT                 I GET_COMPONENTS_INFO           Get Information on Components of the Information Object     .
IF_SRM_VARIANT                 I GET_PROPERTY_INTERFACE        Get  Interface for Property Access                          .
IF_SRM_VERSION                 I CREATE_VARIANT                Create New Variant in this Version                          .
IF_SRM_VERSION                 I DELETE                        Delete Version                                              .
IF_SRM_VERSION                 I GET_COMPONENTS_INFO           Get Information on Components of the Information Object     .
IF_SRM_VERSION                 I GET_VARIANT                   Get a Variant in this Version                               .
IF_SRM_VERSION                 I GET_VARIANTS_INFO             Get Info on All Variants                                    .
IF_SRM_VERSION_HELPER          I INCREASE                      Raise Version Number by One                                 .
IF_SRM_VERSION_INFO            I GET_VERSION_INFO              Read Information on Element Versions                        .
IF_SRM_VERSION_INFO            I GET_VERSION_POID              Get POID Object for an Element Version                      .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_COPY_TO_BE               Copy a View                                                 .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_DELETE_FROM_BE           Delete View from Table                                      .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_DEREGISTRATE             Delete Deleted View from SRMORGROL                          .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_GET_FROM_BE              Get View from Table                                         .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_GET_NAME                 Get Name of View                                            .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_QUICK_ACTION_READ        Read View Quick Action                                      .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_REGISTRATE               Register Specified View in SRMORGROL                        .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_SET_NAME                 Rename View                                                 .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_SET_TO_BE                Save View in Table                                          .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_TEST_EX                  Checks Whether View Already Exists                          .
IF_SRM_VIEWGEN_BE              I VIEW_TRANSPORT                Write Transport Entry for View                              .
IF_SRM_VISUAL_INFO_WIN         I SET_POID                      Set POID for Information                                    .
IF_SRM_VISUAL_INFO_WIN         I SHOW_INFO                     Display info                                                .
IF_SRM_XML                     I CHECK_GID                     CHECK_GID                                                   .
IF_SRM_XML                     I CHECK_ID                      CHECK_ID                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML                     I COPY_SUBTREE_BY_GID           COPY_SUBTREE_BY_GID                                         .
IF_SRM_XML                     I FIND_FROM_GID                 FIND_FROM_GID                                               .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_ALL_MISSING_RESTRICTIONS  GET_ALL_MISSING_RESTRICTIONS                                .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_ATTR_BY_GID               GET_ATTR_BY_GID                                             .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_DESCR1_STR_BY_GID         GET_DESCR1_STR_BY_GID                                       .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_DESCR2_STR_BY_GID         GET_DESCR2_STR_BY_GID                                       .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_DESCRIPTION_BY_GID        GET_DESCRIPTION_BY_GID                                      .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_FATHER_GID                GET_FATHER_GID                                              .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_FATHER_GIDS               GET_FATHER_GIDS                                             .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_FIRSTGID_4_MODELID        GET_FIRSTGID_4_MODELID                                      .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_FREEGID_4_MODELID         GET_FREEGID_4_MODELID                                       .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_ITEMS_BY_GID              GET_ITEMS_BY_GID                                            .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_LASTGID_4_MODELID         GET_LASTGID_4_MODELID                                       .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_LASTID_4_MODELID          GET_LASTID_4_MODELID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_RAW_ATTR_BY_GID           GET_RAW_ATTR_BY_GID                                         .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_REFGID_4_MODELID          GET_REFGID_4_MODELID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_RELATIONS_BY_GID          GET_RELATIONS_BY_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_RESTRICTIONS_BY_GID       GET_RESTRICTIONS_BY_GID                                     .
IF_SRM_XML                     I GET_TOP_GID                   GET_TOP_GID                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML                     I HAS_ELEMENT_CHILDREN          HAS_ELEMENT_CHILDREN                                        .
IF_SRM_XML                     I POPUP_DOM                     POPUP_DOM                                                   .
IF_SRM_XML                     I REMOVE_NODE                   REMOVE_NODE                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML                     I UPD_RELATIONS_BY_GID          UPD_RELATIONS_BY_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML                     I UPD_RESTRICTIONS_BY_GID       UPD_RESTRICTIONS_BY_GID                                     .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I CLEAR                         CLEAR                                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I DELETE_NODE                   DELETE_NODE                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_DELETE                    GET_DELETE                                                  .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_ENABLED                   GET_ENABLED                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_HITS                      GET_HITS                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_MISSING                   GET_MISSING                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_NODE                      GET_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I GET_ROWS                      GET_ROWS                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I SET_NODE                      SET_NODE                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML_CACHE_GID           I SET_NODE_CONDITIONAL          SET_NODE_CONDITIONAL                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_CHECK               I DESCRIPTION_PART1             DESCRIPTION_PART1                                           .
IF_SRM_XML_CHECK               I IS_MINIMAL_COMPAT             IS_MINIMAL_COMPAT                                           .
IF_SRM_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS         GET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_CONTEXT             I SET_ACTIVEONLY                SET_ACTIVEONLY                                              .
IF_SRM_XML_CONTEXT             I SET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS         SET_CHECKRESTRICTIONS                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_CONTEXT             I SET_FILTER_OUT_MODEL          Filter out Model Nodes                                      .
IF_SRM_XML_CONTEXT             I SET_SETONLY                   SET_SETONLY                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_DOCUMENT            I SWITCH_2_CLONE                SWITCH_2_CLONE                                              .
IF_SRM_XML_DOCUMENT            I SWITCH_2_ORIGINAL             SWITCH_2_ORIGINAL                                           .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_ALL_BEHIND_GID            GET_ALL_BEHIND_GID                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_ALL_GID_BY_STATE          GET_ALL_GID_BY_STATE                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_ALL_SET                   GET_ALL_SET                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_FIRST_BEHIND_GID          GET_FIRST_BEHIND_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_NEXT_BEHIND_GID           GET_NEXT_BEHIND_GID                                         .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_NEXT_GID                  GET_NEXT_GID                                                .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_NEXT_GID_RAW              GET_NEXT_GID_RAW                                            .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_PARENT_GID                GET_PARENT_GID                                              .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_POID_BY_GID               GET_POID_BY_GID                                             .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_PREVIOUS_GID              GET_PREVIOUS_GID                                            .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_SPSID_4_SET_BY_GID        GET_SPSID_4_SET_BY_GID                                      .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I GET_STATE_BY_GID              GET_STATE_BY_GID                                            .
IF_SRM_XML_ELEMENT             I UPDATE_XLINKS_BY_GID          UPDATE_XLINKS_BY_GID                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_FILE                I OPEN_DIALOG                   OPEN_DIALOG                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_FILE                I SAVE_DIALOG                   SAVE_DIALOG                                                 .
IF_SRM_XML_INOUT               I PARSE_DOCVERSION              PARSE_DOCVERSION                                            .
IF_SRM_XML_INOUT               I STORE_AND_INDEX               STORE_AND_INDEX                                             .
IF_SRM_XML_MEMORY              I FREE                          FREE                                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_PARSE               I CLIENTFILE                    CLIENTFILE                                                  .
IF_SRM_XML_PARSE               I ITAB                          ITAB                                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_PLAN                I COUNT_POIDS_BY_GID            COUNT_POIDS_BY_GID                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_POID                I COUNT_ALL                     COUNT_ALL                                                   .
IF_SRM_XML_POID                I GET_ALL                       GET_ALL                                                     .
IF_SRM_XML_POID                I GET_FIRST                     GET_FIRST                                                   .
IF_SRM_XML_POID                I GET_NEXT                      GET_NEXT                                                    .
IF_SRM_XML_RECORD              I HAS_ELEMENT_MODEL_CHILDREN    Checks whether the element has model child elements         .
IF_SRM_XML_RELATIONS           I UPDATE_ALL                    UPDATE_ALL                                                  .
IF_SRM_XML_RENDER              I CLIENTFILE                    CLIENTFILE                                                  .
IF_SRM_XML_RENDER              I ITAB                          ITAB                                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I CHECK_BY_GID                  CHECK_BY_GID                                                .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I GET_COUNT_POID_AUTH           GET_COUNT_POID_AUTH                                         .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I GET_COUNT_USER_REST           GET_COUNT_USER_REST                                         .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I INCREMENT_COUNT_POID_AUTH     INCREMENT_COUNT_POID_AUTH                                   .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I INCREMENT_COUNT_USER_REST     INCREMENT_COUNT_USER_REST                                   .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I RESET_COUNT_POID_AUTH         RESET_COUNT_POID_AUTH                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_RESTRICTIONS        I RESET_COUNT_USER_REST         RESET_COUNT_USER_REST                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I CREATE_CHANGE_2_INITIAL       CREATE_CHANGE_2_INITIAL                                     .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I CREATE_UPLOADED               CREATE_UPLOADED                                             .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I GET_CREATE_VERSION            GET_CREATE_VERSION                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I GET_STATE                     GET_STATE                                                   .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_CREATE_VERSION         UPDATE_CREATE_VERSION                                       .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_DESCRIPTION            UPDATE_DESCRIPTION                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_SCHEMA_POID            UPDATE_SCHEMA_POID                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_SEMANTIC_ID            UPDATE_SEMANTIC_ID                                          .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_SPSID                  UPDATE_SPSID                                                .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_STATE                  UPDATE_STATE                                                .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_STYLE_POID             UPDATE_STYLE_POID                                           .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_VERSION_COUNT          UPDATE_VERSION_COUNT                                        .
IF_SRM_XML_ROOT                I UPDATE_XLINKS                 UPDATE_XLINKS                                               .
IF_SRM_XML_SEARCH              I CREATE_ITERATOR_4_GID         SEARCH_CREATE_ITERATOR_4_GID                                .
IF_SRM_XML_SEARCH              I GET_NEXT_ELEMENT              SEARCH_GET_NEXT_ELEMENT                                     .
IF_SRM_XML_SEARCH              I HAS_ELEMENT_SEARCH_STR        Returns whether an element contains a search string         .
IF_SRM_XML_SEARCH_POIDID       I CREATE_ITERATOR_4_GID         SEARCH_CREATE_ITERATOR_4_GID                                .
IF_SRM_XML_SEARCH_POIDID       I GET_NEXT_ELEMENT              SEARCH_GET_NEXT_ELEMENT                                     .
IF_SRM_XML_STRIP               I POIDS                         POIDS                                                       .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_DT_PROVIDER       I GET_INTERFACE_PROPERTIES      Gets DT Properties                                          .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_DT_PROVIDER       I GET_OPERATIONS_WITH_PROPERTIESGets Operations and Properties                              .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_DT_PROVIDER       I GET_SOAP_APPLICATION_NAME     Gets SOAP Application Name                                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_DT_PROVIDER       I TERMINATE                     Terminates Current Object                                   .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROCESSOR         I EXECUTE                       Execute Operation                                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I ASSIGN_LIST                   Assign List of Service Definitions                          .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I DELETE_RT_PROFILE             Delete All Profile Versions                                 .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I DELETE_RT_PROFILE_VERSION     Delete Profile Version                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I REFRESH_ASSIGNMENTS           Refresh Assignments (New RT Configuration and UDDI Entry)   .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I REFRESH_PUBLICATIONS          Refresh Publications (UDDI Entries)                         .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Lock/Unlock Object                                          .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I TERMINATE                     Terminates this object                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_PROFILE_RT        I UNASSIGN_LIST                 Remove List of Service Definitions                          .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I CLEAR                         Deletes Specified or All Tasks from FIFO                    .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I EXECUTE                       Execute Operation                                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I GET_TASK_STATE                Get Processing State of Operation                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I SET_ASYNC_EXE_MODE            Sets Asynchronous Processing Mode (Default)                 .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I SET_SIMULATION_OFF            Sets Actual Processing                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I SET_SIMULATION_ON             Sets Simulation Mode for Processing                         .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_QUEUE             I SET_SYNC_EXE_MODE             Sets Synchronous Processing Mode                            .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I CREATE_RT_PROFILE             Creates New Runtime Profile                                 .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I DECODE_BASE64                 Decodes String from Base64                                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I DELETE_RT_PROFILE             Deletes All Versions of Profile                             .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I DELETE_RT_PROFILE_VERSION     Deletes Version of Profile                                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I ENCODE_BASE64                 Codes String in Base64                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I GET_ALL_ASSIGNED_CONFIGS      Gets All RT Configurations Including Assignments            .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I GET_ASSIGNMENTS               Gets All Profile Versions with Assignments                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I GET_EXT_NAME_BY_SDEF_NAME     Gets Name of Service Definition (Using External Name)       .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I GET_PROFILES                  Gets All Profile Versions                                   .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I GET_SDEF_NAME_BY_EXT_NAME     Gets Name of Service Definition (Using External Name)       .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I OPEN_DT_PROVIDER              Creates DT Provider                                         .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I OPEN_RT_CONFIG                Creates RT Provider                                         .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I OPEN_RT_PROFILE               Opens Existing Runtime Profile                              .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_REGISTRY          I OPEN_SOAP_APP                 Opens SOAP Application                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I ADD_OP_RT_PROPERTIES          Add Operation-Specific Runtime Properties                   .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I ADD_RT_PROPERTIES             Add Properties                                              .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I DELETE                        Deletes RT Configuration                                    .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_ACCESS_URL                Gets Access URL                                             .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_DESCRIPTION_TEXT          Gets Description of Configuration                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_DT_INTERFACE              Gets Read Interface for DT Object                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_OP_RT_PROPERTIES          Gets Runtime Properties for Specified Operation             .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_RT_PROPERTIES             Gets Runtime Properties                                     .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_SERVICE_DEF_WSDL_URL      Gets WSDL URL for Service Definition                        .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I GET_WSDL_URL                  Gets WSDL URL                                               .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I SAVE                          Saves RT Configuration                                      .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Sets Editing Mode                                           .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I SET_OP_RT_PROPERTIES          Sets Operation-Specific Runtime Properties                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I SET_RT_PROPERTIES             Sets Runtime Properties                                     .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I SET_UDDI_REGISTRY             Sets Name of UDDI Registry for Publication                  .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I TERMINATE                     Terminates Current Object                                   .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I UDDI_HIDE                     Unpublishes RT Configuration in UDDI                        .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_RT_CONFIG         I UDDI_PUBLISH                  Publishes RT Configuration in UDDI                          .
IF_SRTFT_CFG_SOAP_APP          I GET_MAPPING_RULES             Gets SOAP Mapping Rules                                     .
IF_SRT_GENERATOR               I GEN_CODE                      Generate Code for RFC/BAPI VIs                              .
IF_SRT_GENERATOR               I GEN_ST                        Generate Simple Transformations for RFC/BAPI VIs            .
IF_SRT_GENERATOR               I GEN_XSD                       (Test Only)                                                 .
IF_SRT_GENERATOR               I GET_TYPES                     Gets Type Description as XML Schema                         .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I ACTIVATE                      Activates LP                                                .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I CHECK                         Checks LP                                                   .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I CLONE                         Creates Copy of LP                                          .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivates LP                                              .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I DELETE                        Deletes LP from Database                                    .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SAVE                          Saves LP to Database                                        .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SET_DEFAULT_PORT              Sets Port to Default/Regular Logical Port                   .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets Description of LP                                      .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SET_EDIT_MODE                 Sets Edit Mode                                              .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SET_HTTP_DESTINATION          Sets HTTP Destination (Deletes URL Implicitly)              .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I SET_URL                       Sets URL (Deletes HTTP Destination Implicitly)              .
IF_SRT_LP_CONFIG               I TERMINATE                     Terminates this Instance of Logical Port                    .
IF_SRT_LP_MAINTENANCE_APPL     I SET_EDIT_MODE                 D = DISPLAY; C = CHANGE                                     .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I CHECK_IF_LP_EXISTS            Returns 'X' if LP Exists                                    .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I CHECK_IF_PROXY_EXISTS         Returns 'X' if Proxy Exists                                 .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I CREATE_LOGICAL_PORT           Returns Configuration Instances of New Logical Port         .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I GET_DEF_PORT_BY_PROXY_CLASS   Returns Name of Default Logical Port                        .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I GET_PORTS_BY_CALL_PROGRAM     Returns All LPs Created/Modified by Caller Program          .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I GET_PORTS_BY_PROXY_CLASS      Returns All Logical Port Names for Given Proxy Class        .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I GET_PROXY_CLASSES             Returns All Proxy Class Names                               .
IF_SRT_LP_REGISTRY             I OPEN_LOGICAL_PORT             Returns Configuration Instance of Logical Port              .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I ADD_TO_REGISTRY               Enter Web Service in the Runtime Registry                   .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I CHECK                         Check Web Services                                          .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I CREATE_BY_ID                  Generate Object for Existing Entry                          .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I CREATE_NEW                    Generate Object for New Registry Entry                      .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I DELETE_UDDI_REGISTRATIONS     Delete UDDI Publishings                                     .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I GET_CONFIG_UI                 Call Configuration UI                                       .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I GET_UDDI_REGISTRATIONS        Get UDDI Publishings                                        .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I GET_WSD_HEADER                Get Header Data from Web Service Definition                 .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I GET_WSD_LIST                  Get Web Service Definitions                                 .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I REMOVE_FROM_REGISTRY          Delete WebService from Runtime Registry                     .
IF_SRT_REGISTRY_ENTRY          I SET_TRANSPORT                 Sets Transport Property                                     .
IF_SRT_WSDL_GEN                I CONFIGURE                     Initialize from Service Configuration                       .
IF_SRT_WSDL_GEN                I ENABLE_SAP_FEATURE            Add SAP Feature to WSDL                                     .
IF_SRT_WSDL_GEN                I GET_WSDL                      Generates WSDL Documents                                    .
IF_SRT_WSDL_GEN                I SET_DOCUMENT_STYLE            Switch from RPC to Document Style                           .
IF_SRT_WSDL_GEN                I SET_RPC_STYLE                 Switch from Document to RPC Style                           .
IF_SRV_OUTBINDING_XMS_PROP     I ADD_BINDING                   Adds Binding to Binding Table                               .
IF_SRV_OUTBINDING_XMS_PROP     I CLEAR_BINDINGS                Deletes Binding Table                                       .
IF_SRV_OUTBINDING_XMS_PROP     I GET_BINDING                   Gets Binding                                                .
IF_SRV_OUTBINDING_XMS_PROP     I GET_BINDINGS                  Gets Binding Table                                          .
IF_SRV_OUTBINDING_XMS_PROP     I SET_BINDINGS                  Sets Binding Table                                          .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I LOAD_TEXT_INPUT               Input Fields and Text Area                                  .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I OPEN_FORM                     "smartxsf"                                                  .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I SET_HREF_FOR_URL              href=                                                       .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_ADDRESS                 "address"                                                   .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_ARCHIVE                 "archive" ... "/archive"                                    .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_COUNTER                 "counter"                                                   .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_CTAG                    "chr"                                                       .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_DATA                    "data"                                                      .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_FAX                     "telefax" ... "/telefax"                                    .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_FORM_TEXT               "form-text" or "include-text"                               .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_GENERAL                 "general" ... "/general"                                    .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_GRAPHIC                 "graphics"                                                  .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_HEADER                  "header"                                                    .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_ICON                    "icon"                                                      .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_INCLUDE_TEXT            Set Indicator for SAPscript Text                            .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_MAIL                    "mail" ... "/mail"                                          .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_NEW_LINE                "new-line/"                                                 .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_NEW_PAGE                "new-page/"                                                 .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_PAGE                    "page/"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_PARAGRAPH               "p"                                                         .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_PRINT_CONTROL           "print-control/"                                            .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SAP_CHARACTER           Not implemented in 6.20                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SBODY                   "sbody"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SECTION                 "section"                                                   .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SFOOT                   "sfoot"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SHEAD                   "shead"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_SYMBOL                  "sym"                                                       .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TABLE                   "Table"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TABSTOP                 "tab/"                                                      .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TBODY                   "tbody"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TCELL                   "tc"                                                        .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TEMPLATE_CELL           "tc"                                                        .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TEXT_MODULE             Set Indicator for Text Module                               .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TFOOT                   "tfoot"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_THEAD                   "thead"                                                     .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_TROW                    "tr"                                                        .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_URL                     "url"                                                       .
IF_SSF_XSF                     I WRITE_WINDOW                  "window"                                                    .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I ADD_OBJPARAMETERS             Add Object Parameter                                        .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I ADD_PARAMETER                 Add Parameter                                               .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I GET_MESSAGE                   Get Message by Index                                        .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I GET_RESULT_DOCUMENT           Get Result Document (iXML Document)                         .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I NUM_MESSAGES                  Get Number of Messages from Last Transformation             .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I OUTPUT_STREAM                 Output Result Document to iXML Output Stream                .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I RUN                           Run Transformation                                          .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I SET_TRANSFORMATION_METHOD     Set Transformation Method                                   .
IF_SSF_XSF_TRANSFORMATION      I SET_XSF_DOCUMENT              Set XSF Document (iXML Document)                            .
IF_STATE_CK                    I GET_STATE                     Save Status in Status Object                                .
IF_STATE_CK                    I SET_STATE                     Restore Status from Status Object                           .
IF_STATE_OBJECT_CK             I INVALIDATE                    Reject Status Object                                        .
IF_STATE_OBJECT_CK             I SET_STATE                     Restore Status at the Runtime Object                        .
IF_STATUS_MANAGED_FIEB         I DISPLAY                       Display                                                     .
IF_STATUS_TRANSACTION          I CHANGE_STATUS                 Change Status                                               .
IF_STRINGABLE                  I AS_STRING                     returns string representation of this instance              .
IF_SUSR_CUA_SWITCH             I AFTER_SWITCH                  Method After the CUA Status Change                          .
IF_SUSR_CUA_SWITCH             I BEFORE_SWITCH                 Method Before the CUA Status Change                         .
IF_SVER_VER02218               I M1_IMPL                       Test method (implemented)                                   .
IF_SVER_VER02218               I M2_NOT_IMPL                   Test method (not implemented)                               .
IF_SWCV                        I GET_BASES                     Gets Base Components for a Component                        .
IF_SWDCL_ACL_CLIENT            I GET_ACL                       Determine ACL                                               .
IF_SWDCL_ACL_CLIENT            I GET_SUPPORTED_PRIVILEGES      Determine Possible Privileges                               .
IF_SWDCL_ACL_CLIENT            I SET_ACL                       Set ACL                                                     .
IF_SWDCL_BASIC_SEARCH_CLIENT   I EXECUTE_QUERY                 Run Search Query                                            .
IF_SWDCL_BASIC_SEARCH_CLIENT   I GET_SUPPORTED_OPERATORS       Query Valid Operators                                       .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_ACL_CLIENT                Prepare Instance for ACL Client                             .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_BASIC_SEARCH_CLIENT       Prepare Instance for Basic Search Client                    .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_DAV_CONNECTION            Prepare Current Connection Object                           .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_ERROR_FROM_RESPONSE       Get Error Information from Response                         .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_LOCK_CLIENT               Prepare Instance for Lock Client                            .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_NAMESPACE                 Get Namespace of Element                                    .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_NAMESPACE_CLIENT          Prepare Instance for Namespace Client                       .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_OPTIONS                   Options Supported by WebDAV Server                          .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_PROPERTY_CLIENT           Prepare Instance for Property Client                        .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_SUPPORTED_METHODS         Methods Supported by Resource                               .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I GET_VERSION_CLIENT            Prepare Instance for Version Client                         .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I INIT_NAMESPACES               Initialize Namespaces                                       .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I INIT_TRACE                    Initialize Trace                                            .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SAVE_NAMESPACES               Find and Flag Namespaces                                    .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SEND_AND_RECEIVE_HTTP_REQUEST Send and Receive HTTP Request                               .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SET_AUTHORITY                 Set Authority                                               .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SET_HTTP_BODY                 Set HTTP Body Data                                          .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SET_HTTP_METHOD               Set WebDAV Method and General Data                          .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SET_LOCK_TOKEN                Set Lock Token                                              .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I SET_NAMESPACES                Set All Namespaces                                          .
IF_SWDCL_CLIENT                I WRITE_TRACE                   Write Trace                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I ACCEPT_COOKIE                 Accept Cookies                                              .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_BASIC_AUTHORIZATION       Get Basic Authorization                                     .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_DAV_URL                   URL with Server Path/Servlet Name                           .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_HOST                      Gets Host                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_HTTP_CLIENT               Gets HTTP Client                                            .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_HTTP_PROTOCOL             Gets HTTP Protocol                                          .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_ID                        Gets ID (Temporary ID for Identifying Instance)             .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_PASSWORD                  Gets Password                                               .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_PATH                      Gets Server Path                                            .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_PORT                      Gets Port                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_RESOURCE_URL              URL Without Server Path/Servlet Name                        .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_RFC_DESTINATION           Get RFC Destination                                         .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_SERVER                    Gets Server Address                                         .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_TRACE_OPTIONS             Gets Trace Options                                          .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I GET_USER                      Gets User                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_CONNECTION            I SET_TRACE_OPTIONS             Sets Trace Options                                          .
IF_SWDCL_ITERATOR              I GET_NEXT                      Next Element                                                .
IF_SWDCL_ITERATOR              I HAS_NEXT                      Other Elements Exist                                        .
IF_SWDCL_ITERATOR              I REMOVE                        Remove Current Element from Iteration                       .
IF_SWDCL_LOCK_CLIENT           I LOCK                          Lock Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_LOCK_CLIENT           I UNLOCK                        Delete lock                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I COPY                          Copy Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I CREATE_COLLECTION             Create Collection                                           .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I CREATE_LINK                   Create Link                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I DELETE                        Delete Resource                                             .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I GET_CONTENT                   HTTP Get                                                    .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I MOVE                          Move Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_NAMESPACE_CLIENT      I WRITE_CONTENT                 HTTP Put                                                    .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I CREATE_ITERATOR               Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_CHILDREN                  Get Bottom Level Privileges                                 .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_NAMESPACE                 Get Namespace                                               .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_NAMESPACE_PREFIX          Get Namespace Prefix                                        .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_PARENT                    Parent                                                      .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I GET_PRIVILEGE                 Privilege                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_PRIVILEGE             I IS_AGGREGATE                  Aggregated Privilege                                        .
IF_SWDCL_PROPERTY_CLIENT       I GET_PROPERTIES                Get Properties of Resource                                  .
IF_SWDCL_PROPERTY_CLIENT       I GET_SUPPORTED_PROPERTIES      Get Possible Properties of Resource                         .
IF_SWDCL_PROPERTY_CLIENT       I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Properties for Resource                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CANCEL_CHECKOUT               Cancel Check Out                                            .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CHECKIN                       Check In Resource                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CHECKOUT                      Check Out Resource                                          .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I COPY                          Copy Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CREATE_COLLECTION             Create Collection                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CREATE_LINK                   Create Link                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I CREATE_RESOURCE               Create Resource                                             .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I DELETE                        Delete Resource                                             .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I DELETE_LOCK                   Delete Lock                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I ENABLE_VERSIONING             Activate Versioning for Resource                            .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_ACL                       Determine ACL                                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_ACTIVE_LOCK               Gets Lock Information                                       .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CHILDREN                  Gets 'Children'                                             .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CHILDREN_FROM_BUFFER      Gets 'Children' in Buffer. No Access to Server.             .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CONTENT_AS_STREAM         Read Content                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CONTENT_AS_TABLE          Read Content                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CONTENT_LENGTH            Gets File Size                                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Gets MIME Type                                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CONTENT_URL               Gets WebDAV URL for Access to Content                       .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_CREATIONDATE              Created On                                                  .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_DISPLAY_NAME              Gets Display Name                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_ETAG                      Gets ETAG                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_LABELS                    Gets Labels                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_LASTMODIFIED              Last Changed On                                             .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_LINK_TYPE                 Gets Link Type                                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_LINK_URL                  Gets Link                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_NAME                      Gets Name (= Last Part of URL)                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_OPTIONS                   Options Supported by URL                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_PARENT                    Gets Parent Collection                                      .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_PREDECESSORS              Get Predecessor Versions                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_PROPERTIES                Get Properties                                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_RESOURCE_DATA             Resource Data as Structure                                  .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_SUCCESSORS                Get Successor Versions                                      .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_SUPPORTED_METHODS         Methods Supported by URL                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_SUPPORTED_PRIVILEGES      Get Supported Privileges                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_SUPPORTED_PROPERTIES      Properties Supported by URL                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_URL                       Gets URL                                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_VERSIONS                  Get Versions                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I GET_VERSION_NAME              Get Version Names                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I HAS_CHANGED                   Resource modified                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I HAS_CHILDREN                  Does resource have 'children'?                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I HAS_VERSIONS                  Do versions exist?                                          .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_CHECKED_IN                 Is resource checked in?                                     .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_CHECKED_OUT                Is resource checked out?                                    .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_COLLECTION                 Collection?                                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_LINK                       Is resource an external link?                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_LOCKED                     Is resource locked?                                         .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I IS_PERSISTENT                 Resource saved persistently                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I MOVE                          Move Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I READ                          Read Data for Resource (Again)                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I REMOVE_LABEL                  Delete Label                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I REMOVE_PROPERTIES             Delete Properties                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SAVE                          Save Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_ACL                       Define ACL                                                  .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_CONTENT_AS_STREAM         Save Content                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_CONTENT_AS_TABLE          Save Content                                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_DISPLAY_NAME              Sets Display Name                                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_LABEL                     Set Label                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_LOCK                      Lock Resource                                               .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Properties                                              .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I SET_URL                       Set URL (if Not Persistent)                                 .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE              I UPDATE                        Copies Attributes and Content of Another Resource           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Checks Existence of Resource                                .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I CREATE_COLLECTION             Creates Object Reference for Collection                     .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I CREATE_FROM_DATA              Creates Object Reference for Resource                       .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I CREATE_LINK                   Creates Object Reference for Link                           .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I CREATE_RESOURCE               Creates Object Reference for Resource                       .
IF_SWDCL_RESOURCE_FACTORY      I GET_RESOURCE                  Gets Object Reference for Resource                          .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I CHECKIN                       Check In Resource                                           .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I CHECKOUT                      Check Out Resource                                          .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I GET_LABELS                    List of All Labels                                          .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I GET_PREDECESSORS              List of All Predecessor Versions                            .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I GET_SUCCESSORS                List of All Successor Versions                              .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I GET_VERSION_LIST              List of All Versions                                        .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I MAINTAIN_LABELS               Set/Delete Label                                            .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I REMOVE_LABELS                 Delete Label                                                .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I SET_LABELS                    Set Label                                                   .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I UNCHECKOUT                    Cancel Check Out                                            .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I UPDATE                        Copies Attributes and Content of Another Resource           .
IF_SWDCL_VERSION_CLIENT        I VERSION_CONTROL               Controls Versions of Resource                               .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I DELETE                        Deletes Job                                                 .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I GET_INTERVAL                  Gets Interval (Period in Sec)                               .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I GET_JOBCLASS                  Gets Job Class                                              .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I GET_JOBNAME                   Gets Job Name                                               .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I GET_REPORTNAME                Gets Program Name                                           .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I GET_VARIANT                   Gets variant to be used, or is empty                        .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I INSERT                        Creates and Starts Job                                      .
IF_SWF_ADM_JOB                 I SET_INTERVAL                  Sets Interval (Min)                                         .
IF_SWF_ALM_ANALYZE             I CALL_ANALYZE_TOOL             Calls the Analyze Tool                                      .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I GET_ALERT_ID                  Returns the alert ID                                        .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I GET_T100_MESSAGE              Returns a T100 message from the buffer                      .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I RAISE                         Trigger Alert                                               .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I RAISE_EXCEPTION               Trigger Alert with CX_SWF_IFS_EXCEPTION                     .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I RAISE_T100_MESSAGE            Trigger Alert with T100 Message                             .
IF_SWF_ALM_CONTEXT             I SET_T100_MESSAGE              Sets a T100 message in the buffer                           .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I EXPORT_BINDING_EXECUTE        Execute Export Binding                                      .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I GET_EXPORT_BINDING            Read Binding Definition for Time EXPORT                     .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I GET_IMPORT_BINDING            Read Binding Definition for Time IMPORT                     .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I GET_LEGACY_BINDING            Export Binding Definition After " 5.0                       .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I IMPORT_BINDING_EXECUTE        Execute Import Binding                                      .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I SET_EXPORT_BINDING            Set Binding Definition for Time EXPORT                      .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I SET_IMPORT_BINDING            Set Binding Definition for Time IMPORT                      .
IF_SWF_BND_BINDING             I SET_LEGACY_BINDING            Set Binding Definition from Definition " 5.0                .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I CLEAR_COMP_VALUE              Sets Value of Component to Type-Based Initial Value         .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I GET_COMP_VALUE                Delivers a Copy of the Value of the Component               .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I GET_COMP_VALUE_REF            Delivers a Data Reference to the Value of the Component     .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I LIST_COMPONENTS               Delivers a List with Names of all (Top-Level) Component     .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I SET_COMP_VALUE                Sets the Value of the Component (Using an ABAP Field)       .
IF_SWF_BND_COMP_VALUE_ACCESS   I SET_COMP_VALUE_REF            Sets the Value of the Component (Using a Data Reference)    .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I CHECK                         Can Binding Operation Be Used for Expressions Given?        .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I EXECUTE                       Call Binding                                                .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I GET_OPTIONS_FROM_BINDING      Extract Options from Binding Statement                      .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I GET_PROPERTIES                Attributes of Operation                                     .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I GET_SUPPORTED_OPTIONS         Deliver the Options Supported by this Operator              .
IF_SWF_BND_OPERATION           I SET_BINDING_FROM_OPTIONS      Set Options Selected in Editor in Binding Statement         .
IF_SWF_BND_TRANS_EXTENSION     I EDIT_TRANSFORMATION           Dialog to Parameterize this Transformation                  .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I CALL_ANALYSIS_TOOL            Call Analysis Tool                                          .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I EXECUTE_OKCODE                Evaluation of OK Code, Call Analysis Tools                  .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I GET_DOKU_OBJECT               Gets Docu Object Key                                        .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I GET_OWN_CLASSNAME             Gets Name of Separate Class                                 .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I GET_STATUS                    Gets a GUI Status                                           .
IF_SWF_CCMS_ANALYSIS           I GET_TITLE                     Gets a Text for the Title                                   .
IF_SWF_CCMS_DATA_PROVIDER      I COLLECT_DATA                  Collect data                                                .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I DELETE_ALERTS                 Delete Alerts                                               .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_PERFORMANCE_ATTR       Report Performance Value                                    .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_PROTOCOL_ATTR          Report Log Attribute                                        .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_PROTOCOL_ATTR_BY_T100  Report Log Attribute with T100 Message                      .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_STATUS_ATTR            Report Status                                               .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_STATUS_ATTR_BY_T100    Report Status with T100 Message                             .
IF_SWF_CCMS_REPORT             I REPORT_TEXT_ATTR              Report Text Attribute                                       .
IF_SWF_CCMS_STRUCTURE          I BUILD_STRUCTURE               Create and Save CCMS Structure                              .
IF_SWF_CCMS_STRUCTURE          I GET_METHOD_PROPERTIES_BY_ID   Gets Method Information By Using the ID                     .
IF_SWF_CCMS_STRUCTURE          I GET_PROCESS_CATEGORY          Gets Process Category                                       .
IF_SWF_CCMS_STRUCTURE          I GET_SHORTTEXT_BY_ID           Gets Short Text of a Node By Using the ID                   .
IF_SWF_CCMS_STRUCTURE          I GET_TID_BY_ID                 Gets TID Using the Internal ID (Name)                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_ARCHIVE             I FROM_ARCHIVE_FORMAT           Conversion from the Archive Format                          .
IF_SWF_CNT_ARCHIVE             I GET_ARCHIVE_TABLE             Determine Table Format                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ARCHIVE             I TO_ARCHIVE_FORMAT             Conversion to Archive Format                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_BOR_CONTAINER       I CREATE_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Instance Based on a BOR - Generate Container Structure      .
IF_SWF_CNT_BOR_CONTAINER       I IMPORT_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Data Import from a BOR - Container Structure                .
IF_SWF_CNT_BOR_CONTAINER       I TO_BOR_CONTAINER              Fills a BOR - Container Structure                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I AFTER_CONSTRUCTOR_CALL        Set Attribute(s) of a New Container Instance                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I CLEAR_PROPERTIES              Delete Attribute(s)                                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I CLONE                         Copies the Container and All Elements                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I CLONE_AS_PROTOTYPE            Creates Empty Container with Current Container as Definition.
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I EDIT                          Calls the Container Editor                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I ELEMENT_COPY                  Copy Element                                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I GET_CHANGE_DATA               Delivers the Change Data of the Container                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I GET_ITERATOR                  Delivers Iterator Object for the Container                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I GET_LAST_EXCEPTION            Gets the last exception that occurred                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I GET_PROPERTIES                Get Attribute(s)(Default: Get ALL Attributes)               .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I GET_TEXTS                     Query Text of the Container                                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I INITIALIZE                    Delete All Elements and Reset the Container                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I MERGE                         Merge Elements of a Second Container                        .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I QUERY                         Query Whether Attribute(s) Is/Are Set                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_CHANGE_DATA               Set Change Data of the Container                            .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_GUID                      Sets the Unique ID of the Container                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_LAST_EXCEPTION            Sets internal error variable                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_LPOR                      Set Persistence (ID + Persistence Class)                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_PERSISTENCE               Determines the Persistence Class                            .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_PROPERTIES                Set Attribute(s)                                            .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER           I SET_TEXTS                     Set Short Text and Long Text of Container                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER_EXPR      I EXPR_CLEAR                    Reset or delete expression                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER_EXPR      I EXPR_GET                      Fetch expression object                                     .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER_EXPR      I EXPR_GET_VALUE                Determine Value of Expression                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONTAINER_EXPR      I EXPR_SET                      Set Expression in the Container                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I CHECK                         Consistency Check(s) on a Container                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I CREATE_FROM_ABAP_CONTAINER    Generate Instance and Transfer Elements from ABAP Container .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I CREATE_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Instance from a BOR - Generate Container Structure          .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I CREATE_FROM_XML               Instantiate Container from XML Data Stream                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_ABAP_CONTAINER    Set Element Value from ABAP Method Container                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Data Import from a BOR - Container Structure                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_PARAM_CONTAINER   Data Import from IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER             .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_SIMPLE_CONTAINER  Data Import from a Name Value Pair Structure                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_XML               Fill Container Instance from XML Data Stream                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I TO_ABAP_CONTAINER             Copy Elements to an ABAP Method Container                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I TO_BOR_CONTAINER              Copy Element to a BOR Container Structure                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I TO_SIMPLE_CONTAINER           Copy Element (Name/Value Pair) to a SimpleContainer         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION          I TO_XML                        Container (with Meta Attributes) to XML Data Stream         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I CHECK                         Consistency Check(s) on a Container                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I COMPARE                       Compare Container                                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I CREATE_FROM_ABAP_CONTAINER    Generate Instance and Transfer Elements from ABAP Container .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I CREATE_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Instance from a BOR - Generate Container Structure          .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I CREATE_FROM_XML               Instantiate Container from XML Data Stream                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I IMPORT_FROM_ABAP_CONTAINER    Set Element Value from ABAP Method Container                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I IMPORT_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Data Import from a BOR - Container Structure                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I IMPORT_FROM_SIMPLE_CONTAINER  Data Import from a Name Value Pair Structure                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I IMPORT_FROM_XML               Fill Container Instance from XML Data Stream                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I IMPORT_FROM_XML_GP            Fill Container Instance from XML Data Stream                .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I TO_ABAP_CONTAINER             Copy Elements to an ABAP Method Container                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I TO_BOR_CONTAINER              Copy Element to a BOR Container Structure                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I TO_SIMPLE_CONTAINER           Copy Element (Name/Value Pair) to a SimpleContainer         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I TO_XML                        Container (with Meta Attributes) to XML Data Stream         .
IF_SWF_CNT_CONVERSION_SERVICE  I TO_XML_GP                     Container (with Meta Attributes) to XML Data Stream         .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I CLEAR_BEFORE_IMAGE            Delete Available Intermediate Status                        .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I COMPARE                       Compare Container with Other Container                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I CREATE_BEFORE_IMAGE           Save Current Status as Intermediate Status                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I GET_BEFORE_IMAGE              Call Saved Intermediate Status                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I TOUCH                         Mark Container as 'Changed'                                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_DELTA_HANDLING      I UNTOUCH                       Mark Container as 'Unchanged'                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I ASSIGN                        Assign Elements to One Another                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CLEAR_PROPS                   Reset Attribute(s)                                          .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CLEAR_VALUE                   Reset Element Value to Type-Based Initial Value             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I COPY                          Create Copy of the Element                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CREATE_BY_DATA                Define Element Using an ABAP Field (Type + Value)           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CREATE_BY_REFERENCE           Define Element Using Data Reference (Type + Value)          .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CREATE_BY_TYPEDESCR           Define Element Using an ABAP Type Descriptor (Type Only)    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I CREATE_BY_TYPENAME            Generate Element Using Direct Entry of (Object) Type Names  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I DISPLAY                       Display Element as Dialog Box                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I EDIT                          Edit Element (Definition + Value)                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_CHANGE_DATA               Read Change Data of the Element                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_EDITELEM                  Element Name in Uppercase and Lowercase                     .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_EDITELEM_STRING           Element Name in Uppercase and Lowercase (String Format)     .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_EXTENSION_TYPE            States whether element located locally or in an extension   .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_NAME                      Read Name of the Element                                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_NAME_STRING               Name of Element (String Format)                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_OWNER                     Delivers the Container That Manages the Element             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_PROPS                     Determine Attribute(s)                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_QNAME                     Determine Qualified Name of Element                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_REPOSITORY_TYPEINFO       DDIC/BOR/SE24 Determine Type Information Using an Element   .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_TEXTS                     Deliver Display Name, Description, and Short Text           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_TYPE                      Determines Type Names and Type Attributes                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_TYPEDESCR                 Determine Type Descriptor (From Type Name or Value)         .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_UNIT                      Determine Element Unit                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_UNIT_REF                  Determine Reference to Unit of Element                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_UNIT_TYPE                 Determine Unit Type of Element                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_VALUE                     Determine Element Value                                     .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I GET_VALUE_REF                 Determine Data Reference to Value Element                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I HAS_PROPS                     OBSOLETE! -" Use 'QUERY'                                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I INITIALIZE_VALUE              Generate Initial Element Value                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I IS_ALIVE                      'X' - Element Reference Is Active                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I QUERY                         'X' - Use Attribute(s)                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I REFRESH_OBJECT_REFERENCE      If Object Value: Reload Object from DB                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_ARGTYPE                   Set Argument Type (For Dynamic Method Call)                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_CHANGE_DATA               Set Change Data of Element                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_NAME                      Set Name of Element                                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_OWNER                     Sets the Container That Manages the Element                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_PROPS                     Set Attribute(s)                                            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_QNAME                     Set Qualified Name of Element                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_TEXTS                     Sets the Display Name, Description, and Short Text          .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_TYPE                      Determines Type Name Reference                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_UNIT                      Set Element Unit                                            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_VALUE                     Set Element Value                                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT             I SET_VALUE_REF                 Set Data Reference That Shows the Value of the Element      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ALL_ELEMENTS_GET_COUNT        Number of Elements That Correspond to the Criteria Entered  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ALL_ELEMENTS_INITIALIZE       Resets All Elements to Type-Based Initial Value             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ALL_ELEMENTS_LIST             Deliver List (If Necessary, Filtered) of Element Names      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ALL_ELEMENTS_REFRESH_TEXTS    Read Language-Dependent Texts of All Elements               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_CLEAR_PROPS           OBSOLETE. Only Set Properties Using Element Class           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_COPY                  Copy Element                                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_EXISTS                Element of This Name Available in the Container?            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_GET_DEFINITION        Generate Element Interface Reference for Element            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_GET_PROPS             Get Attribute(s) of Element                                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_GET_TEXTS             Query Text of Element                                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_GET_VALUE             Query Value and Unit of Element                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_GET_VALUE_REF         Query Value and Unit of Element Using Data References       .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_INITIALIZE            Initialize Element Value                                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_QUERY                 Test Attributes of Element                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_REMOVE                Remove Element from Container                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_RENAME                Rename Element                                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_SET_DEFINITION        Insert Element from Element Interface Reference             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_SET_PROPS             OBSOLETE. Only Set Properties Using Element Class           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_SET_VALUE             Set Value and Unit of Element                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS      I ELEMENT_SET_VALUE_REF         Set Value and Unit of Element Using Data References         .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ALL_ELEMENTS_GET_COUNT        Number of Elements That Correspond to the Criteria Entered  .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ALL_ELEMENTS_INITIALIZE       Resets All Elements to Type-Based Initial Value             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ALL_ELEMENTS_LIST             Deliver List (If Necessary, Filtered) of Element Names      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ALL_ELEMENTS_REFRESH_HANDLES  Read Handles in All Object-Type Elements                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ALL_ELEMENTS_REFRESH_TEXTS    Read Language-Dependent Texts of All Elements               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_CLEAR_PROPS           Reset Element Attributes (Delete)                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_COPY                  Copy Element                                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_EXISTS                Element of This Name Available in the Container?            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_GET_DEFINITION        Generate Element Interface Reference for Element            .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_GET_PROPS             Query Attribute(s) of Element                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_GET_TEXTS             Query Text of Element                                       .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_GET_VALUE             Query Value and Unit of Element                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_GET_VALUE_REF         Query Value and Unit of Element Using Data References       .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_INITIALIZE            Initialize Element Value or Reset to Default                .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_QUERY                 Query Element Attributes -" Xfield                          .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_REMOVE                Remove Local Element from Container                         .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_RENAME                Rename Element                                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_SET_DEFINITION        Insert Element Locally                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_SET_PROPS             Set Element Attributes                                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_SET_VALUE             Set Value and Unit of Element                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_ELEMENT_ACCESS_1    I ELEMENT_SET_VALUE_REF         Set Value and Unit of Element Using Data References         .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_GET                Get Expression Object from the Container                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_GET_DEF            Deliver Element Definition                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_GET_VALUE          Determine Value of Expression and Put in Variable           .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_GET_VALUE_REF      Determine Value of Expression                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_REMOVE             Remove Expression from the Container                        .
IF_SWF_CNT_EXPRESSION          I EXPRESSION_SET                Set Expression in the Container                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I CREATE                        Generate                                                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_COUNT                     Number of objects                                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_CURRENT                   Current object                                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_FIRST                     First Object                                                .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_LAST                      Last Object                                                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_NEXT                      Next Object                                                 .
IF_SWF_CNT_ITERATOR            I GET_PREVIOUS                  Previous object                                             .
IF_SWF_CNT_MASS_DATA_HANDLING  I INSTANTIATE                   Instantiation of Container Objects                          .
IF_SWF_CNT_MASS_DATA_HANDLING  I LOAD                          Mass Loading of Container Data                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I AFTER_CONSTRUCTOR_CALL        Set Attribute of the Persistence Manager                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I CHECK_CONTAINER_SAVEABLE      Checks Whether the Container Elements Can Be Saved          .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I DELETE                        Delete Persistent Representation of the Instance            .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Container Texts (All Languages)                      .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I DETACH                        'Log Off': The Persistence Instance Is No Longer Used       .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I GET_BUSINESS_CLASS_INSTANCE   Determine Instance of the Business Class                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I GET_IBF_PORB                  Delivers a Persistence Object Reference of Type SIBFLPORB   .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I GET_INSTANCE_BY_KEY           Generate Instance Using POR Entered (Re-Instantiation)      .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I GET_POR                       Delivers a Persistence Object Reference of Type SWFUTLPOR   .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I GET_REFRESH_FLAG              Reload Object Before the Next Attribute Access of DB?       .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I LOAD                          Load Instance Data from the DB                              .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I LOAD_TEXT                     Load Container Texts (Language-Dependent)                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I SAVE                          Make Instance Persistent                                    .
IF_SWF_CNT_PERSISTENCE         I SAVE_TEXT                     Save Container Texts (Language-Dependent)                   .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I CLEAR                         Sets the Parameter to a Type-Based Initial Value            .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I GET                           Delivers the Value to a Parameter                           .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I GET_REF                       Delivers the Data Reference to the Value of a Parameter     .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I LIST_NAMES                    Delivers a List with the Names of all Parameters            .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I SET                           Sets the Value of a Parameter                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_SIMPLE_CONTAINER    I SET_REF                       Sets the Value of a Parameter Using a Data Reference        .
IF_SWF_CNT_TEST                I CLASS_SETUP                   Static Setup of Test Class                                  .
IF_SWF_CNT_TEST                I CLASS_TEARDOWN                Static Teardown of Test Class                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_TEST                I SETUP                         Setup Before Each Test Method                               .
IF_SWF_CNT_TEST                I TEARDOWN                      Teardown After Each Test Method                             .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I COMPONENT_ADD                 Adds a New Component                                        .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I COMPONENT_REMOVE              Removes a Component                                         .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I DEQUEUE                       Delete Enqueue Lock                                         .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I ENQUEUE                       Set Enqueue Lock                                            .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_COMPONENTS                Delivers the Components                                     .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_CONTAINER                 Delivers the Parameter of the Correlation (Container)       .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_EXIT_OBJECT_CHECK         Gets the Exit for Checking an Object                        .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_HEADER                    Delivers the Header Data of the Correlation                 .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_KEY                       Delivers the Key of the Correlation                         .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I GET_TEXTS                     Delivers the Text                                           .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I SET_EXIT_OBJECT_CHECK         Sets the Exit for Checking an Object                        .
IF_SWF_CRL_DEF_CORRELATION     I SET_TEXTS                     Setzt the Text                                              .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I AUTO_MAINTENANCE              Automatic Execution                                         .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I CHECK                         Checks execution status                                     .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I EXECUTE                       Executes activity                                           .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I GET_DOCU_OBJ                  Gets object key of SE61 text                                .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I GET_STATE                     Gets status of check                                        .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I GET_TITLE                     Gets describing text of object                              .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I GET_VIEWCLASS                 Returns view class                                          .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I SEND_MESSAGE                  Sets message about customizing status                       .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK                I SET_VIEWCLASS                 Sets view class                                             .
IF_SWF_CST_TASK_VISIBILITY     I IS_VISIBLE                    Specifies whether a customizing task should be displayed    .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_CONDITIONS                Returns the condition list                                  .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns the workflow container (prototype instance)         .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_CONTAINER_DEFINITION      Returns the container PROTOTYPES (cannot be changed)        .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_DEF_CLASS_NAME            Returns the implementing class of the definition            .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_FIRST_STEPS_OF_BLOCK      Returns the first step of a block                           .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_GUID                      Returns the GUID of the definition                          .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_LAST_STEP_OF_BLOCK        Returns the last step of a block                            .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_LOG_PROFILE               Returns the name of the log profile                         .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_NEXT_BLOCK                Returns the next step to be executed                        .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_NEXT_STEPS                Returns the next step to be executed                        .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_PERSIST_RUN_CLASS_NAME    Returns the name of the work item persistence class         .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_POR_OF_INSTANCE           POR of Current Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_PROFILE                   Returns the database profile                                .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_RESULTS                   Returns the outcomes of a step                              .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_RUN_CLASS_NAME            Returns the implementing class of the runtime               .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_STEP                      Returns a step                                              .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I GET_TASK                      Returns the workflow task (org object)                      .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_CONTROL     I LOAD                          Load the workflow definition                                .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_BINDING                   Gets Current Binding Object                                 .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns Step Container                                      .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_CONTAINER_DEFINITION      Returns Step Container Definition (PROTOTYPE)               .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_DEF_CLASS_NAME            Gets Name of Implementing Class (Definition)                .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_PERSIST_RUN_CLASS_NAME    Gets Name of Persistent Class (RUNTIME)                     .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_POR_OF_INSTANCE           POR of Current Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_PROCESS                   Returns Corresponding Process Control                       .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_RESULTS                   Returns Result (List) of Step                               .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I GET_RUN_CLASS_NAME            Gets Name of Implementing Class (RUNTIME)                   .
IF_SWF_DEF_PROCESS_STEP        I HAS_RESULT                    Checks Whether a Result Was Modeled                         .
IF_SWF_EVT_ERROR_CONTEXT       I SET_MESSAGE                   Sets the message                                            .
IF_SWF_EVT_ERROR_CONTEXT       I SET_NOTIFY_RECEIVERS          Sets the receivers of the message                           .
IF_SWF_EVT_ERROR_CONTEXT       I SET_RETRY_TIMESTAMP           Sets the time stamp for the next retry (temp.)              .
IF_SWF_EVT_ERROR_CONTEXT       I SET_SEND_NOTIFICATION         Sets the indicator for sending a message                    .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I CHECK                         Checks the Event                                            .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_EVENT_CONTAINER           Delivers a Reference for Event Parameters                   .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_EVENT_NAME                Delivers the Event Name                                     .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_HANDLER_COUNTERS          Delivers counter using the handler after trigger            .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_OBJECT_KEY                Delivers the Object Key                                     .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_OBJTYPE_NAME              Delivers the Object Type Names/Classes Names                .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I GET_PROPERTY                  Gets property of the event                                  .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I RAISE                         Triggers the event                                          .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I RAISE_IN_UPDATE_TASK          Triggers the event in the V1 update                         .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I SET_CREATOR                   Sets the generator of the event                             .
IF_SWF_EVT_EVENT               I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets a property for the event                               .
IF_SWF_EVT_HANDLER             I GET_FUNCTION                  Delivers a function module                                  .
IF_SWF_EVT_HANDLER             I GET_METHOD                    Delivers a method                                           .
IF_SWF_EVT_HANDLER             I IS_FUNCTION                   Shows whether the handler is a function module              .
IF_SWF_EVT_HANDLER             I IS_METHOD                     Shows whether the handler is a method                       .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I GET_ACTIVATION                Delivers the activation                                     .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I GET_INSTANCE_MASTER           Delivers the reference entry (master)                       .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I GET_STATUS                    Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I IS_FOR_ALL_INSTANCES          Shows whether the linkage applies to all instances          .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I SAVE_TO_DATABASE              Saves the linkage                                           .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I SET_ACTIVATION                Sets the activation                                         .
IF_SWF_EVT_INSTANCE_LINKAGE    I SET_STATUS                    Sets the Status                                             .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I GET_HANDLER                   Delivers the event handler                                  .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I IS_FOR_ALL_INSTANCES          Shows whether the linkage is entered for all instances      .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I IS_INSTANCE_MASTER            Shows whether it is a reference entry for instances         .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I REFRESH                       Updates the data (from database)                            .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SAVE_TO_DATABASE              Saves the linkage                                           .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_ACTIVATION                Sets the activation                                         .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_CHECK_FB                  Sets the check function module                              .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_DELIVERY_MODE             Sets the type and method of delivery                        .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_DELIVERY_PARAMETER        Sets parameters for delivery                                .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_ERROR_BEHAVIOUR           Sets behavior in the event of an error                      .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_HANDLER                   Sets the event handler (CAUTION)                            .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_HANDLER_OBJTYPE           Sets the object types for the handler                       .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_IMPLICIT_SAVE             Sets a flag to save immediately if changes are made         .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_IMPLICIT_TRANSPORT        Sets whether transport dialog to be executed upon saving    .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_QUEUE_ENABLING            Sets queue use                                              .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_RECTYPE_GET_FB            Sets the receiver type function module                      .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_RFC_DESTINATION           Sets the RFC Destination                                    .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I SET_STATUS                    Sets the linkage status                                     .
IF_SWF_EVT_TYPE_LINKAGE        I TRANSPORT                     Transports the linkage                                      .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I CHECK                         Operator Useable for the Operands Entered?                  .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Operator for the Operands Entered                  .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I GET_OPERATOR                  Unique, INTERNAL String Representation of the Operator      .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I GET_PRECEDENCE                Order Determined for Other Operators                        .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I GET_VALENCE                   Deliver Valency (Preferred Number of Arguments) of Operator .
IF_SWF_EXP_ARITHMETIC          I OPERATION                     Code of Actual Comparison Operation                         .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I CHECK                         Check Expression Against Container                          .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I CLEAR_PROPS                   Delete Selected Attribute(s) of Expression                  .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I COPY                          Make Copy                                                   .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I CREATE                        Generate Expression Object                                  .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I DISPLAY                       Display Expression                                          .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I EDIT                          Edit Expression                                             .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_COMPONENT_DETAILS         Deliver Details About the Expression Components             .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_CONTAINER                 Determine Container (Namespace of Expression)               .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_EXPRESSION                Determine Expression (Parts)                                .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_PROPS                     Determine Attribute(s)                                      .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_REF_ELEMENTS              List of All Container Elements Required for the Evaluation  .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_RUNTIME                   Runtime of Last Expression Evaluation                       .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_TARGET_ELEMENT            Deliver Value as Container Element (DEFINITION TIME)        .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_TYPE                      Type Attributes of Value                                    .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE                     Determine Value                                             .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE_ELEMENT             Deliver Value as Container Element (RUNTIME)                .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE_REF                 Determine Reference to Value                                .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I INITIALIZE                    Reset Expression Object Completely                          .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I QUERY                         Attribute(s) Available?                                     .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I SET_CONTAINER                 Set Container (Namespace of Expression)                     .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I SET_EXPRESSION                Set Expression Source Text                                  .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I SET_PROPS                     Set Selected Attribute(s) of Expression                     .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I SET_VALUE_REF                 Set Value of the Field Referenced in the Expression         .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I TO_STRING                     Change Value to a Character Chain                           .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I VALUE_TO_HTML                 Change Value to a Character Chain with HTML Formatting      .
IF_SWF_EXP_EXPRESSION          I VALUE_TO_STRING               Change Value to a Character Chain                           .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I DEFINITION_CLEAR              De-Register Definition Extension                            .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I DEFINITION_GET                Determine Definition Extension (Instance)                   .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I DEFINITION_GET_IBF_POR        Determine Definition Extension (POR), SIBFLPORB Format      .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I DEFINITION_SET                Set Definition Extension (Change -" Local Buffer)           .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDES_GET_ALL              Determine List of All Included Container Instances          .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDE_CLEAR                 De-Register Included Container Instance                     .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDE_GET                   Query Instance of Include Extension Using Its Name          .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDE_GET_IBF_POR           Query POR of Include Extension Using Its Name               .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDE_GET_PROPERTIES        Query Attributes of an Included Container                   .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I INCLUDE_SET                   Register Included Container Instance                        .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I NAVIGATE                      Path Navigation in Container Extension Structure            .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I PARENT_CLEAR                  Deregister Parent                                           .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I PARENT_GET                    Determine Parent (Instance)                                 .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I PARENT_GET_IBF_POR            Determine Parent (POR), SIBFLPORB Format                    .
IF_SWF_EXP_NAMESPACE           I PARENT_SET                    Sets Connection to Higher-Level Instance                    .
IF_SWF_EXP_OUTPUT_CONVERSION   I OUTPUT_CONVERT                Output Conversion for an Expression                         .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets the Describing Short Text (40 Characters)              .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I GET_LANGUAGE                  Supplies Current Language                                   .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I GET_LONGTEXT                  Gets the Long Text                                          .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I GET_SHORTTEXT                 Gets the Describing Text (132 Characters)                   .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets the Describing Short Text (40 Characters)              .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets the Current Language, Gets the Text Again, If Necessary.
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I SET_LONGTEXT                  Sets the Long Text                                          .
IF_SWF_EXP_TEXT_ACCESS         I SET_SHORTTEXT                 Sets the Describing Text (132 Characters)                   .
IF_SWF_GP_API_FRAMEWORK        I GET_MESSAGE_OBJECT            Gets Message Object                                         .
IF_SWF_GP_API_FRAMEWORK        I GET_TRC_HANDLE                Gets Trace Handle                                           .
IF_SWF_GP_API_FRAMEWORK        I SET_TRC_CONTEXT               Sets Trace Context                                          .
IF_SWF_GP_API_FRAMEWORK        I WRITE_TRACE                   Writes Trace                                                .
IF_SWF_GP_API_FRAMEWORK        I WRITE_TRACE_EXC               Writes Exception Data in Trace                              .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_ATTRIBUTES            Gets the attributes of a node with an activity type         .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_CHILDS_BY_NODE        Gets the children of an instance with a specific node number.
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_LOOP_COUNT            Gets the maximum loop counter of specified loop             .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_PROCESSORS_T          Gets the possible and actual agents                         .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_SIBLINGS_COND         Gets the instances of the alternatives of a condition       .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_ACI_SIBLINGS_LOOP         Gets further activities for an instance                     .
IF_SWF_GP_PROCESS_STATE        I GET_GPI_ATTRIBUTES            Gets attributes of a guided procedure (also subprocess)     .
IF_SWF_GP_ROLE_INSTANCE        I GET_USERS                     Read User of Process Role                                   .
IF_SWF_GP_ROLE_INSTANCE        I SET_USERS                     Fill Role with Agents                                       .
IF_SWF_GP_ROLE_INSTANCE        I SET_WIID                      Set Work Item ID                                            .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_ACTION                  Visit Action                                                .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_ACTION_DECISION         Visit Decision                                              .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_ALT_CONDBLOCK           Visit Conditional                                           .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_ALT_DECIBLOCK           Visit Decision Block                                        .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_LOOP_UNTIL              Visit Until Loop                                            .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_LOOP_WHILE              Visit While Loop                                            .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_PARALLEL                Visit Parallel Block                                        .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_PROCESS                 Visit Process                                               .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_SEQUENCE                Visit Sequence                                              .
IF_SWF_GP_STEP_VISITOR         I VISIT_SUBPROCESS              Visits Subprocess                                           .
IF_SWF_IFS_ASYNCHRONOUS_RULE   I INITIATE_EVALUATION           Trigger Asynchronous Rule Resolution                        .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get (language-specific) description                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I GET_ICON                      Gets graphic symbol                                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I GET_NAME                      Get unique DISPLAY name                                     .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I GET_SYMBOL                    Gets unique INTERNAL name                                   .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I GET_TEXT_KEY                  Gets SE61 key for long text (F1 help)                       .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I TO_HTML                       Gets HTML display (for output in HTML control)              .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_PRESENTATION   I TO_STRING                     Gets string display (for dynpro output)                     .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM      I CHECK                         Compatibility Check                                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM      I GET_SUPPORTED_OPTIONS         Deliver Options That Support This Transformation            .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM      I TRANSFORM                     Data Transformation                                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM_CONT I CHECK                         Compatibility Check                                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM_CONT I GET_SUPPORTED_OPTIONS         Deliver Options That Support This Transformation            .
IF_SWF_IFS_BIND_TRANSFORM_CONT I TRANSFORM                     Data Transformation Between Two Containers                  .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I CLEAR_PROPERTIES              Delete configuration attribute(s)                           .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I CREATE                        Create new, initial container instance                      .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I GET                           Get container instance from buffer, or from DB              .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I GET_PROPERTIES                Query configuration attribute(s)                            .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I QUERY                         Container instance in buffer?                               .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I RESET_FACTORY                 Resets Factory Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONTAINER_FACTORY   I SET_PROPERTIES                Set configuration attribute(s)                              .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I COPY                          Copy elements between parameter containers                  .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_BOR_CONTAINER     Data Import from a BOR - Container Structure                .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_IFS_XML           Data import from IFS-XML datastream                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_IFS_XML_SCHEMA    Container Definition from IFS XML Schema                    .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I IMPORT_FROM_SIMPLE_CONTAINER  Data import from a list of name/value pairs                 .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I TO_BOR_CONTAINER              Export to a BOR container structure                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I TO_IFS_XML                    Serialization in IFS-XML Datastream                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I TO_IFS_XML_SCHEMA             Serialization in IFS-XML schema                             .
IF_SWF_IFS_CONVERSION          I TO_SIMPLE_CONTAINER           Export to list of name/value pairs                          .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_CONTAINER                 Determine Container (Namespace of Expression)               .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_EXPRESSION                Determine expression definition                             .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_TYPE                      Type properties of (expression) value                       .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE                     Evaluate expression                                         .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE_ELEMENT             Get value of expression as container element                .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I GET_VALUE_REF                 Determine reference to (expression) value                   .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION          I QUERY                         Property available? Gets XFELD                              .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I EXPR_GET                      Generate Expression Object (Using Instance Buffer)          .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I EXPR_GET_VALUE                Evaluate Expression (Using Instance Buffer)                 .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I EXPR_GET_VALUE_REF            Evaluate Expression (Using Instance Buffer) Gets REF TO DATA.
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I GET_DEFAULT_CONTAINER         Deliver Default Container                                   .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I RESET_EXPRESSION_VALUES       Resets the values of all buffered expressions               .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I RESET_FACTORY                 Resets Factory Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPRESSION_FACTORY  I SET_DEFAULT_CONTAINER         Set Default Container                                       .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPR_CONTAINER      I EXPR_CLEAR                    Reset or delete expression                                  .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPR_CONTAINER      I EXPR_GET                      Fetch expression object                                     .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPR_CONTAINER      I EXPR_GET_VALUE                Determine Value of Expression                               .
IF_SWF_IFS_EXPR_CONTAINER      I EXPR_SET                      Set Expression in the Container                             .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I CLEAR                         Sets the Parameter to a Type-Based Initial Value            .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I GET                           Delivers the Value to a Parameter                           .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I GET_REF                       Delivers the Data Reference to the Value of a Parameter     .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I LIST_NAMES                    Delivers a List with the Names of all Parameters            .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I SET                           Sets the Value of a Parameter                               .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETERS          I SET_REF                       Sets the Value of a Parameter Using a Data Reference        .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I CLEAR                         Reset to Type-Based Initial Value/Default Value             .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I GET                           Delivers the Value of an Element/Parameter                  .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I GET_TYPE                      Delivers the Data Type of the Element/Parameter             .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I GET_VALUE_REF                 Delivers the Reference to the Value of an Element/Parameter .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I LIST_NAMES                    Delivers a List with the Names of all Parameters            .
IF_SWF_IFS_PARAMETER_CONTAINER I SET                           Sets the Value of an Element/Parameter                      .
IF_SWF_IFS_ROUTE_WFXML_1_0     I GET_STATUS_CHANGED_EVENT      Delivers the Event Name: Status Change                      .
IF_SWF_IFS_ROUTE_WFXML_1_1     I GET_NOTIFY_EVENT              Delivers the Event Name: Notify                             .
IF_SWF_IFS_ROUTE_WFXML_1_1     I GET_STATUS_CHANGED_EVENT      Delivers the Event Name: Status Change                      .
IF_SWF_IFS_ROUTE_WFXML_BETA    I GET_STATUS_CHANGED_EVENT      Delivers the Event Name: Status Change                      .
IF_SWF_IFS_SERIALIZER          I DESERIALIZE                   Retrieve data object from XML display                       .
IF_SWF_IFS_SERIALIZER          I SERIALIZE                     Generate XML display for data object                        .
IF_SWF_IFS_WORKITEM_EXIT       I EVENT_RAISED                  Event Generated                                             .
IF_SWF_LOG_CONTEXT             I GET_COPY_VALUES               Gets context values that are copied                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_CONTEXT             I GET_REFERENCE_VALUES          Gets context values that are referenced                     .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_COMPONENT                 Gets the component of the entry                             .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_ENTRY_GUID                Gets the GUID of the entry (generated key)                  .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_LEVEL                     Gets the level                                              .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_LOG_PERSISTENCE           Gets the persistence reference of the log entry             .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_MESSAGE                   Gets the log message                                        .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_PREVIOUS_ENTRY            Gets the predecessor of the entry                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_PROFILE                   Gets the log profile of the entry                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_PROGRAM                   Gets the program name                                       .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_SOURCE_LINE               Gets the line number in source code                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_SPECIFIC_DATA             Gets the specific data                                      .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Gets the time stamp                                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I GET_USERNAME                  Gets the user for the log entry                             .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_LEVEL                     Sets the level                                              .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_MESSAGE                   Sets the log message                                        .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_PREVIOUS_ENTRY            Sets the predecessor of the entry                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_PROGRAM                   Sets the program name                                       .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_SOURCE_LINE               Sets the line number in source code                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_SPECIFIC_DATA             Sets the specific data                                      .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_TIMESTAMP                 Sets the time stamp                                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_ENTRY               I SET_USERNAME                  Sets the user for the log entry                             .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I ADD_ENTRIES                   Adds multiple log entries                                   .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I ADD_ENTRY                     Adds a log entry                                            .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I CONVERT_TO_STRUCTURE          Converts an entry to a structure                            .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I CONVERT_TO_TABLE              Converts entries to an internal table                       .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I EXTRACT_BY_COMPONENT          Extracts the entries of a component                         .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I EXTRACT_BY_LEVEL              Extracts the entries of a level                             .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I GET_CONTEXT_ENTRY             Gets the context log entry                                  .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I GET_ENTRIES                   Gets the log entries to be written                          .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I IS_ENTRY_REQUIRED             Checks whether an entry has been written                    .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I REMOVE_ENTRIES                Removes log entries from existing set                       .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I SAVE                          Saves collected log entries                                 .
IF_SWF_LOG_MANAGER             I SET_CONTEXT_ENTRY             Sets a context log entry                                    .
IF_SWF_LOG_PERSISTENCE         I GET_LOGTYPE                   Gets the log types                                          .
IF_SWF_LOG_PERSISTENCE         I GET_SPECIFIC_STRUCTURE_NAME   Gets the structure name for the specific log data           .
IF_SWF_LOG_PERSISTENCE         I SAVE_ENTRIES                  Saves the transferred log entries                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_PROFILE             I GET_COMPONENT_LEVEL           Gets the set level of a component                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_PROFILE             I GET_DOCU_NAME                 Gets the name of the text in the dialog                     .
IF_SWF_LOG_PROFILE             I GET_PROFILE_NAME              Gets the name of the profile                                .
IF_SWF_LOG_PROFILE_WHERE_USED  I GET_WHERE_USED_COUNTER        Gets the number of uses and dialog if available             .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I ADD_READ_COMPONENT            Adds a component to be read                                 .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I CLEAR                         Initializes the set of log entries                          .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I GET_ENTRIES                   Gets the log entries                                        .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I GET_WHERE_CONDITION           Gets the where condition                                    .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I READ                          Reads the entries                                           .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I REMOVE_READ_COMPONENT         Removes a component to be read                              .
IF_SWF_LOG_READER              I SET_WHERE_CONDITION           Sets the where condition for reading the data               .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I FIND_BY_KEY                   Finds mail object                                           .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_ATTACHMENTS               Determines attachments                                      .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_BODY                      Determines body                                             .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_BODY_HEX                  Determines body in hex format (HEX)                         .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_DOCUMENT_TYPE             Gets document type                                          .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_KEY                       Returns key                                                 .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_LABEL                     Determines object name                                      .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_LANGUAGE                  Determines language                                         .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_OBJECT_TYPE               Determines type of mail                                     .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_RECEIVERS                 Determines recipient                                        .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I GET_TITLE                     Determines title                                            .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I IS_BODY_HEX                   Checks whether body saved in hex format                     .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I REMOVE                        Deletes mail object                                         .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SAVE                          Saves (sends) mail                                          .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_ATTACHMENTS               Sets Attachments                                            .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_BODY                      Sets body                                                   .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_BODY_HEX                  Sets body in hex format                                     .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_DOCUMENT_TYPE             Sets document type                                          .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_LABEL                     Sets object name                                            .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets language                                               .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_OBJECT_TYPE               Sets type of mail                                           .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_RECEIVERS                 Sets recipient                                              .
IF_SWF_MAIL_OBJECT_PROXY       I SET_TITLE                     Sets title                                                  .
IF_SWF_MAIL_SYSTEM_PROXY       I CLOSE                         Terminate connection                                        .
IF_SWF_MAIL_SYSTEM_PROXY       I CONNECT                       Establish Connection to Mail System                         .
IF_SWF_MAIL_SYSTEM_PROXY       I GET_CLASSNAME                 Gets implementing class                                     .
IF_SWF_MAIL_SYSTEM_PROXY       I GET_MAIL_OBJECT               Gets mail object of mail system                             .
IF_SWF_PDEF_EXPORT             I CONVERT                       Converts external document into internal data               .
IF_SWF_PDEF_EXPORT             I GET_MESSAGES                  Produces list of warnings and errors                        .
IF_SWF_PDEF_IMPORT             I AFTER_SAVE                    Called After Saving (ID and Version)                        .
IF_SWF_PDEF_IMPORT             I CONVERT                       Converts external document into internal data               .
IF_SWF_PDEF_IMPORT             I GET_MESSAGES                  Produces list of warnings and errors                        .
IF_SWF_PF_COLLECTOR            I REGISTER_PERSISTABLE          Registers a persistence object in a transction              .
IF_SWF_PF_COLLECTOR            I START                         Starting measuring                                          .
IF_SWF_PF_COLLECTOR            I STOP                          Clock Measurement                                           .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADD_OBJECT                    Parameterizable by Category                                 .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_CANCEL                  RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_COMPLETE                RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_CONTINUE                RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_ERROR_RESTART           RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_EXECUTE                 RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_READY                   RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ADMIN_STOP_WAITING            RFC                                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I CHANGE_AGENTS                 Schmidtpa                                                   .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I CHANGE_CALLBACK               (Change CB-FB with W,B,F) No longer exists?                 .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I CHANGE_CONTAINER              Indirection may be required because RUN must have knowledge?.
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I CREATE                        Interesting interface                                       .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I DELETE_OBJECT                 Parameterizable by Category                                 .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I ENQUEUE                       Who locks when? Client must, what do WIM and WFM do?        .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I EXECUTE_DARK                  fka. sww_wi_without_wlc_execute                             .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I EXECUTION_DISABLE             Lock Executability                                          .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I EXECUTION_ENABLE              Unlock Executability                                        .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I GET_AAGENT                    Return to Header...                                         .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I GET_TASKDESC                  Where is replacement called?                                .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I GET_WORKFLOW_LOG              Analog swp_workflow_log_read: Entire Structue of Workflow   .
IF_SWF_RDG_WI                  I START                         Interesting interface. Caution: Generated caller            .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I CHECK_RANGE_TABS              Checks Range Tables for Consistency                         .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I CLEAR                         Delete Current Selection                                    .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I GET_DB_ENTRIES                Read Selected Entries (DB Entries)                          .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I GET_ENTRIES                   Read Selected Entries                                       .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I GET_TABLENAME                 Name of database table                                      .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I READ                          Select from Database                                        .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I SET_DB_ENTRIES                Set Preselected Entries (DB Entries)                        .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I SET_DONT_IGNORE_NON_ID_RANGES Sets "Do Not Ignore Other Selections as WI ID"              .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets Language for Selection Result                          .
IF_SWF_REP_HEADER_SELECTION    I SET_RANGE_TAB                 Set a Range Table                                           .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_FILTER     I EXECUTE                       Apply Filter to Entries                                     .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_FILTER     I GET_ENTRIES                   Read Selected Entries                                       .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_FILTER     I SET_ENTRIES                   Set Entries to Be Processed                                 .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I CHECK_RANGE_TABS              Checks Range Tables for Consistency                         .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I CLEAR                         Delete Current Selection                                    .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I GET_DB_ENTRIES                Read Selected Entries                                       .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I GET_DONT_IGNORE_NON_ID_RANGES Gets "Do Not Ignore Other Selections as WI ID"              .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I GET_ENTRIES                   Read Selected Entries                                       .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I READ                          Select from Database                                        .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I REFRESH                       Repeat selection                                            .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_DONT_IGNORE_NON_ID_RANGES Sets "Do Not Ignore Other Selections as WI ID"              .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_FILTER_STRATEGY           Set Filter Strategy                                         .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets Language for Selection Result                          .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Additional Properties for Selection                    .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_RANGE_TAB                 Set a Range Table                                           .
IF_SWF_REP_WORKITEM_SELECTION  I SET_TIME_PERIOD               Set Selection Period                                        .
IF_SWF_RLS_BOOLEAN             I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Condition (Gets Truth Value)                       .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I CHECK                         Operator Useable for the Operands Entered?                  .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Operator for the Operands Entered                  .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I GET_OPERATOR                  Unique, INTERNAL String Representation of the Operator      .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I GET_PRECEDENCE                Order Determined for Other Operators                        .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I GET_VALENCE                   Deliver Valency (Preferred Number of Arguments) of Operator .
IF_SWF_RLS_COMPOP              I OPERATION                     Code of the Comparison Operation Used                       .
IF_SWF_RLS_RULE                I GET_CONTAINER                 Gets container (namespace) of rule                          .
IF_SWF_RLS_RULE                I GET_RESULT                    Evaluate Rule (Gets value of result expression)             .
IF_SWF_RLS_RULE                I GET_RESULT_EXPRESSION         Gets result expression                                      .
IF_SWF_RLS_RULE                I GET_RULE_ID                   Gets unique (physical) ID of rule                           .
IF_SWF_RLS_RULE                I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets container (namespace) of rule                          .
IF_SWF_RLS_UNARY_COMPOP        I CHECK                         Operator Useable for the Operands Entered?                  .
IF_SWF_RLS_UNARY_COMPOP        I EVALUATE                      Evaluate Operator for an Expression                         .
IF_SWF_RLS_UNARY_COMPOP        I GET_OPERATOR                  Unique, INTERNAL String Representation of the Operator      .
IF_SWF_RLS_UNARY_COMPOP        I OPERATION                     Perform the Unitary Operation                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_ADHOC_PROXY         I SET_STATUS_COMPLETED          Sets Status to Completed                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_CALLBACK_ENTRY      I DISCARD                       Entry Can Be Deleted                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_CALLBACK_ENTRY      I GET_CALLING_BACK_WIID         Work Item ID                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_CALLBACK_ENTRY      I GET_TRACE_DATA                Gets Trace Data                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_CALLBACK_ENTRY      I REENQUEUE                     Request must be repeated                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_CALLBACK_ENTRY      I SET_STATUS_ERROR              Sets Status to 'ERROR'                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_CONTEXT             I GET_EXPRESSION_FACTORY        Expression Factory                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_CONTEXT             I IS_RUNTIME_ACTIVE             Runtime Active                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I BACK                          Replace                                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I FORWARD                       Forward (Parameter Missing)                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I GET_COMMANDS                  Read Permitted Commands (Returns Object List)               .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I GET_STATUS                    Read Current Status (Returns Object)                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I REJECT                        Reject                                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I RESUBMISSION_END              End resubmission                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I RESUBMIT                      Resubmit                                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_INBOX_OBJECT        I SELECT                        Accept (Parameter Missing)                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_PARAMETER           I GET_ITERATOR_EXPORT_PARAMETER Create Iterator for Export Parameters                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_PARAMETER           I GET_ITERATOR_IMPORT_PARAMETER Create Iterator for Import Parameters                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENCE_CLASS   I GET_INSTANCE_BY_KEY           Instantiation of Object                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENCE_CLASS   I GET_POR_OF_INSTANCE           POR of Current Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENCE_CLASS   I LOAD                          Load Object Data                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENCE_CLASS   I SAVE                          Write Object Data to Corresponding DB Tables                .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I GET_HEADER_IMAGE              Read Complete Header Data (Structure SWFRSTP)               .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I SET_HEADER_IMAGE              Set Complete Header Data (Struceture SWFRSTP)               .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I SET_P_INSTANCE                Sets Instance of Corresponding Persistent Class             .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENT_PC_OBJ   I GET_PC_HEADER_IMAGE           Read Complete Header Data (Structure SWFRPROCTR)            .
IF_SWF_RUN_PERSISTENT_PC_OBJ   I SET_PC_HEADER_IMAGE           Set Complete Header Data (Structure SWFRPROCTR)             .
IF_SWF_RUN_RESULT              I GET_RESULT                    Returns the Result                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_SERVICE             I EXECUTE                       Execution of Service                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_SERVICE             I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets Service Properties                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_BINDING               Gets Binding                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_COMP_EVENTS           Gets Terminating Event                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_CONDITION             Gets Conditions                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_FUNCTIONS             Gets Programming Exits                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_HEADER                Gets Header                                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_METHODS               Gets Methods                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_NODE                  Gets Nodes                                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_NODEID                Gets Node ID                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_NODETYPE              Gets Node Type                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_PROPERTIES            Gets Additional Step Attributes                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_STEP                  Gets Step                                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_WITEXT                Gets Work Item/Node Text                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_PERSIST_RECEIVER          Persist Recipient                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_WF_TASK_HANDLE            Gets Flow Task Handle                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_WILLBRANCH                Gets Information Whether Case was Generated                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I IS_BINDING_AVAILABLE          Gets Binding Available                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I IS_COMP_EVENTS_AVAILABLE      Gets Terminating Events Available                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I IS_CONDITIONS_AVAILABLE       Gets Conditions Available                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I IS_FUNCTIONS_AVAILABLE        Gets Programming Exits Available                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_STEP_ATTRIBUTES     I IS_METHODS_AVAILABLE          Gets Methods Available                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DED_ROLE_BINDING          Binding for Required End                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_BINDING               Workflow: Bindings                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_CONDITIONS_WFM        Workflow: Conditions                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_CONDITIONS_WIM        Workflow: Conditions                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_CONTAINER             Workflow: Container Definition                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_EVENTS                Workflow: Events for Rule-Based Workflow                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_FUNCTIONS             Workflow: Programming Exits                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_HEADER                Workflow: Header                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_LEVENTS               Workflow: Local Events and Exceptions to Blocks             .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_LINES                 Workflow: Links                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_METHODS               Workflow: Methods                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_NODES                 Workflow: Node                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_PROPERTIES            Workflow: Properties                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_ROLE_BINDING          Determines Binding for Default Processor                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_STEPS                 Workflow: Activities                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_DEF_WFDWIZ                Workflow: Determines Key of Workflow                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_LANGUAGE                  Gets language of instance                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_LED_ROLE_BINDING          Binding for Latest End (Deadline)                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_LSD_ROLE_BINDING          Binding for Latest Start                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_MAIN_METHOD_DEFINITION    Characteristics of Main Method                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_NAME                      Gets name of task                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_NOT_ROLE_BINDING          Determines Binding for Notifications                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_START_EVENT_BINDING       Determines Binding for Start Event                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_ATTRIBUTES           Determines Task Characteristics                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_COMP_EVENTS          Terminating events                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_CONTAINER            Instance Container                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_GUID                 Determines GUID of Task for Instance Management             .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_INIT_BINDING         Initial Binding for Task                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_OM_BINDING           Data Flow Task -" Method                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TASK_START_EVENTS         Start events                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_TERM_EVENT_BINDING        Determines Binding for Completed Event                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_TASK_ATTRIBUTES     I GET_WITYPE                    Gets work item type                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_TRANSACTION         I ACTIVATE                      Activate Transaction Control                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_TRANSACTION         I PASSIVATE                     Deactivate Transaction Control                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM                 I CANCEL                        Cancels a complete workflow                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM                 I RUN                           Starts Workflow Manager Session                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I CANCEL_WORKFLOW               Cancels Workflow                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I COMPLETE_WF_BY_CONTROL        Ends workflow using control step                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I CONSUME_LOCAL_EVENTS          Uses a local event                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_EXEC_COMPONENT         Deletes a component from execution queue                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_NXTNOD_FOR_COMPONENT   Deletes next node for component GUID from queue             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I ENQUEUE_NEXT_NODES            Adds new entries to NEXT_NODES queue                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_BINDING_DEFINITION        Reads binding definition for a step or node                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_NODE_DEFINITION           Gets node definition for node ID                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_STEP_DEFINITION           Gets step definition for node ID                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_WFM_MODE                  Gets mode of WFM                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_WFM_PHASE                 Gets execution phase of WFM                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I GET_WFTYPE                    Gets workflow type                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I ROLLBACK                      Recreates last consistent status                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I SET_WI_CANCEL_ERROR           Reports an error when work item canceled                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_INTERNAL        I SET_WI_COMPLETE_ERROR         Reports an error when work item set to obsolete             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_LOGGER          I CLEAR                         Deletes internal log buffer                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_LOGGER          I FLUSH                         Writes log buffer to database                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_LOGGER          I WRITE_EXCEPTION               Writes exception to log                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_LOGGER          I WRITE_NODE_INSTANCE           Writes node entry to log                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WFM_LOGGER          I WRITE_STEP_INSTANCE           Writes step entry to log                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I CHANGE_LANGUAGE               Changes Language of Work Item                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I CHANGE_PRIORITY               Changes Priority                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I CHANGE_WITEXT                 Changes Work Item Text                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I DEQUEUE                       Deletes Enqueue Lock                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I ENQUEUE                       Sets Enqueue Lock                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_ADHOC_OBJECTS             Supplies Adhoc Objects                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_ADMINISTRATOR_AGENTS      Gets Administrator                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_AGENTS                    Gets Agent for Processing                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_ATTACH_OBJECTS            Supplies Attachment Objects                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_CBDONE_FLAG_FROM_DATABASE Supplies Callback Flag                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_CREATE_TIMESTAMP          Gets Creation Time                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_DEADLINES                 Delivers Deadlines                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_DEADLINE_AGENTS           Supplies Agent for Deadlines                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_DIALOG_BLOCK_CHILDS       Supplies All Subordinate Workitems of a Dialog Block        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_EI_HEADER                 Supplies Header of Wait Step                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_END_DATE                  Gets End Date / Time / Timestamp                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_EXCLUDED_AGENTS           Supplies Excluded Employees                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_NOTIFICATION_AGENTS       Supplies Agent for End Notification                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_NUMBER_OF_INQUIRIES       Supplies Number of Queries                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_RETURN                    Supplies result of last execution of work item              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_STATUSTEXT                Supplies Text of Work Item Status                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_STATUS_FROM_DATABASE      Supplies Status                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_TOPLEVEL_WORKITEM         Identifies Top-Level Workflow                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_TYPETEXT                  Supplies Text of Work Item Type                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WF_CONTAINER              Supplies workflow container, taking blocks into account     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WF_CONTAINER_LOCAL        Gets workflow container, internal use                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WF_HANDLE                 Gets workflow                                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WF_TASK                   Gets Workflow Name                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WITEXT                    Supplies Work Item Text                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_CONTAINER              Supplies Work Item Container                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_EXECUTION_TIME         Supplies Execution Time in Seconds                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_HEADER                 Supplies Work Item Header                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_HEADER_EXTENDED        Supplies Work Item Header (Enhanced Structure)              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_RESULT                 Supplies Result Structure (WIM"-"WFM)                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I GET_WI_RETURN                 Supplies Return Values of Method Execution and Exceptions   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I IS_ENQUEUED                   Chekcs Whether Work Item is Locked                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM                 I RESUBMIT                      Resubmit                                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC           I ADD_INSTANCE                  Add AdHoc Instance                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC           I COMPLETE_INSTANCE             End AdHoc Instance                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC           I GET_INSTANCE                  Return AdHoc Instance                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC           I GET_INSTANCE_DATA             Return AdHoc Instance as Structure                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC           I HAS_ACTIVE_INSTANCE           Checks Whether an Active (Started) AdHoc Instance Exists    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC_INTERNAL  I REFRESH_AGENTS                Execute Role Resolution for Recipient                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC_INTERNAL  I REFRESH_CONTAINER             Execute Binding Workflow-"Work Item                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC_INTERNAL  I REFRESH_EXCLUDED_AGENTS       Execute Role Resolution for Excluded Agents                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADHOC_INTERNAL  I REFRESH_INBOX                 Refreshes inbox for current work item                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_BACK                      Replacement of work item by administrator                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_CANCEL                    Set Work Item to 'Logically Deleted'                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_DISABLE                   Disable Work Item (Supend)                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_ENABLE                    Enable Work Item (Resume)                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_EVALUATE_CONDITIONS       Execution of Pre-/Postconditions                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_REDO_ROLE_RESOLUTION      Execute Rule Again                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ADM_INTERNAL    I ADM_SET_AGENTS                Assign New Agents to Work Item                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I CLEAR_REQUESTER               Deletes Requester                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I GET_CONTEXT                   Reads Context                                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I GET_CONTEXT_REF               Delivers Reference to the Context                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I GET_REQUESTER                 Reads Semantic Requester                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Context                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CONTEXT         I SET_REQUESTER                 Sets Semantic Requester                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CREATE          I CREATE                        Creates an Instance                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CREATE          I INITIALIZE                    Initializes instance                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I CHECK_AND_CREATE_COMP_EVENTS  Checks or determines terminating events                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I CREATE_WORKFLOW_INSTANCE      Generates workflow instance                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I CREATE_WORKITEM_TEXT          Generates work item text                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I DETERMINE_DEADLINES           Determines deadlines and checks for consistency             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I ENQUEUE_INTERNAL              Enqueue to Work Item                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I EXECUTE_POST_CONDITION        Execute Postcondition with Status Update                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I EXECUTE_PRE_CONDITION         Execute Precondition with Status Update                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I EXECUTE_WAIT_CONDITION        Execute Wait Condition with Status Update                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I GET_AGENTS_FOR_REMOTE_CALLBACKDetermines agent for remote callback (RI)                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I GET_AGENTS_FOR_WORKITEM       Determines agent of work item                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I GET_NEXT_NUMBER               Determine Unique ID                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I PREPARE_SUB_WORKFLOW          Sets properties for subflow                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I RECREATE_WORKITEM             Calculates properties of work item (CHECKED-"READY)         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SEND_EXPRESS_MESSAGE          Send Express Mail                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_HEADER_PROPERTIES         Sets general properties of header                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_NOTE_FLAG                 Sets attachment flag if attachments exist                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_SELFITEM                  Sets self item                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_WF_HANDLE                 Sets workflow handle                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_WITYPE_PROPERTIES         Sets properties for work item type                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_WLC_FLAGS                 Sets WLC_FLAGS field                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_WORKITEM_OBJECT           Sets Work Item Object in Container                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I SET_WORK_QUEUE_ENTRIES        Sets work queue                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I WI_CREATE_RECEIVERS           Create Instance Linkages                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_CRT_INTERNAL    I WI_TRIGGER_EVENT              Generate 'Created' Instance                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEADLINE        I CHECK_DEADLINE_GROUP          Checks deadline group                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEADLINE        I GET_DEADLINE                  Gets deadline object                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEADLINE        I GET_DEADLINE_GROUP            Gets all deadlines                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEADLINE        I SET_DEADLINE_FLAG             Sets flag for deadline existence                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_NODEID                    Determines Node ID                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_NODE_DEFINITION           Determines Node                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_PROPERTIES                Determines Properties for Step                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_RULE                      Determines Rule                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_START_EVENT_BINDING       Determines Binding for Start Event                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_STEP_DEFINITION           Determines Definition of Step                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_STEP_HANDLE               Gets Reference to Step                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_TASK_HANDLE               Determines Task Handle                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_TERM_EVENT_BINDING        Determines Binding for Completed Event                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_URL_EXPRESSION            Determines Expression for URL                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_DEFINITION      I GET_WFDWIZ                    Determines Key of Workflow Definition                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I GET_MAIN_METHOD               Gets Main Method                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I GET_MAIN_METHOD_RETURN        Gets return of main method                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Gets object of main method                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I INCREMENT_EXECUTION_TIME      Increments execution time                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I SET_MAIN_METHOD_RETURN        Sets return of main method                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_EXE_INTERNAL    I SET_START_TIMESTAMP           Sets start time stamp                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_LOG_UTIL_OBJECT           Generates LogUtil object                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_ORG_UTIL_OBJECT           Generates PD OrgUtil object                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_QUERY_OBJECT              Generates query object                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_TICKET_OBJECT             Generates ticket object                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_UTIL_OBJECT               Generates Util object                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_WAPI_OBJECT               Generates WAPI object                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_HELPER          I GET_WORKQUEUE_OBJECT          Generates work queue object                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADD_ATTACHMENT                Add Attachment                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_BACK                      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_CANCEL                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_DISABLE                   Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_ENABLE                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_EVALUATE_CONDITIONS       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_REDO_ROLE_RESOLUTION      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ADM_SET_AGENTS                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CALL_WORKITEM_EXIT            Call Exits                                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHANGE_LANGUAGE               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHANGE_PRIORITY               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHANGE_WITEXT                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHECK_BIT                     Checks Whether the Bit Is Set                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHECK_DEADLINE_GROUP          Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHECK_ORG_AGENT_EXECUTE       Checks whether user permitted to execute work item          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CHECK_STATUS_TRANSITION       Checks Status Transfer                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CLEAR_BIT                     Deletes Bit                                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CLEAR_FLAG_COMP_EVENTS        Initializes Flag                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I COMMIT                        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I COMPUTE_START_TIMESTAMP       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CONFIRM                       Set Work Item to Completed                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I CONSUME_EVENT                 Consumes Event                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DEACTIVATE_ALL_DEADLINE_DATES Deactivates all Deadline Monitoring                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DEACTIVATE_DS_DEADLINE        Deactivates Required Start Date                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DEACTIVATE_START_DEADLINES    Deactivates All Start Deadlines                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DELETE                        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_AGENTS                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_INSTANCE_COUPLING      Deletes All Instance Couplings of Work Item                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_RI_AGENTS              Deletes Agents of Remote Item                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DELETE_SUCCESS                Deletes success message in log                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DEQUEUE                       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I DUMP_OBJ_EXCEPTION_TO_LOG     Writes Exception from Runtime System into the Log           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ENQUEUE                       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_AGENT                Determines Agent of a Type (Notification,...)               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_COMPLETE_CONDITION   Evaluates End Condition for Work Item                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_EXECUTE_IN_BACKGROUNDStarts Execution in Background                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_POST_CONDITION       Evaluates Subsequent Condition for Work Item                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_PRE_CONDITION        Evaluates Precondition for Work Item                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I EVALUATE_WAIT_CONDITION       Evaluates wait condition for work item                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I FREE                          Release of Work Flow (Multi-User Operation)                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_ACTUAL_USER               Determines Current User                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_ADHOC_OBJECTS             Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_ADMINISTRATOR_AGENTS      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_AGENTS                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_ATTACH_OBJECTS            Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_CALL_CONTEXT              Determines Context of Caller (Interface Parameter)          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_CBDONE_FLAG_FROM_DATABASE Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_COMPLETION_EVENTS         Determines terminating event of work item                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_CREATE_TIMESTAMP          Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_DEADLINE                  Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_DEADLINES                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_DEADLINE_AGENTS           Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_DEADLINE_GROUP            Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_DEPENDANT_WIS             Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_EI_HEADER                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_END_DATE                  Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_ENQUEUE_PROPERTIES        Determines Enqueue Properties                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_EXCLUDED_AGENTS           Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_EXECUTION_TIME            Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_LOG_UTIL_OBJECT           Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_MAIN_METHOD               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_MAIN_METHOD_RETURN        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_MAIN_OBJECT               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_NODEID                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_NOTIFICATION_AGENTS       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_NUMBER_OF_INQUIRIES       Determines Number of Requests (sent and open)               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_PARENT                    Determines Father of the Current Item                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_PARENT_TASK_HANDLE        Gets task handle of workflow                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_PARFOREACH_INDEX          Determines ParForEach Index                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_PROCESS_STATUS            Gets process status                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_QUERY_OBJECT              Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_RESTART_ACTIVE            Restart active                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_RETURN                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_RULE                      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_STATE_TRANSITION          Determines Status Transfer                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_STATUSTEXT                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_STATUS_FROM_DATABASE      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_SYSTEM_PROPERTY           Gets internal system statuses of work item                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_SYSTEM_USER               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_TASK_HANDLE               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_TICKET_OBJECT             Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_TOPLEVEL_WORKITEM         Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_TRANSACTION               Determines Current Transaction                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_TRANSIENT_EXECUTION       Delivers Flag Whether Execution Is Transient                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_URL_EXPRESSION            Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_UTIL_OBJECT               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WAPI_OBJECT               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WF_CONTAINER              Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WF_HANDLE                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WF_TASK                   Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WITEXT                    Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_CONTAINER              Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_EXECUTION_TIME         Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_HEADER                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_HEADER_EXTENDED        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_RESULT                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_RETURN                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WI_WFDKEY                 Determines WFDKEY of the Current Flow Item                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WORKITEM_CONTEXT          Determines Work Item Context                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I GET_WORKQUEUE_OBJECT          Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I INCREMENT_EXECUTION_TIME      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I INCREMENT_RETRY_COUNTER       Increments Repetition Counter                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I IS_ENQUEUED                   Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I IS_IN_FINAL_STATE             Object Has Final Status                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I IS_METHODCALL_ASYNCHRON       Asynchronous Method Call                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I MERGE_ADHOC_OBJECTS           Merges AdHoc Objects                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I MERGE_ATTACH_OBJECTS          Merges Attachment Objects                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I MERGE_METHOD_TO_WI_CONTAINER  Merged Method Result in Work Item Container                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I OMIT_MAIL_IF_ERROR            Prevents Mail for Status Transfer After 'ERROR'             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I POP_REQUEST                   Pop Request                                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I PUSH_REQUEST                  Push Request                                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RAISE_EXCEPTION               Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RAISE_STATE_CHANGED           Triggering of Event 'STATE_CHANGED'                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RECEIVE_EVENT                 Receives event                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RECEIVE_INQUIRY               Receives Request                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REDO_RULE_RESOLUTION          Repeats Agent Determination + Excluded Agents               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REFRESH                       Recreate Instance from Database                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REFRESH_AGENTS                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REFRESH_CONTAINER             Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REFRESH_EXCLUDED_AGENTS       Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I REFRESH_INBOX                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RESUBMISSION_END              Exits Resubmission                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I RESUBMIT                      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I ROLLBACK                      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE                          Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_AGENTS_FOR_WORKITEM      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_CONTAINER                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_DEADLINES                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_LOG                      Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_RETURN                   Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_WIHEADER                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SAVE_WORKQUEUE                Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SEND_CONFIRMATION_POPUP       Sendsa Confirmation Popup                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SEND_ERROR_REPAIR_MAIL        Sends error mail to administrator                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SEND_EXPRESS_NOTE             Sends Express Dialog Box                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SEND_INFO_MAIL                Sends Mail to Request Receiver                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SEND_NOTIFICATIONS            Sends Notifications                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_ACTUAL_AGENT              Sets Current Agent                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_ACTUAL_AGENT_TO_CONTAINER Sets Current Agent in Container                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_ACTUAL_AGENT_TO_ORGTASK   Sets Current Processor for OrgTask                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_AI_RELASE_FLAG            Sets Release for Work Queue                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_BIT                       Sets Bit                                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_CB_DONE                   Sets Callback Flag of Work Item                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_CB_DONE_TO_DB             Sets Callback Flag of Work Item with Update to DB           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_DEADLINES                 Sets Work Item Deadlines                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_DEADLINE_FLAG             Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_DEADLINE_STATUS           Sets Deadline Status of Work Item Using Event (DE;LE,LS,DS) .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_DEF_GUID                  Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_EI_HEADER                 Sets Header of Wait Step                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_END_DATE                  Sets End Date                                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_EXCEPTION_OBJECT          Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_EXECUTION_ADDRESS         Sets Execution Address                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_FORWARDER                 Sets forwarding                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_INQUIRY                   Saves Reference to Query                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_LOG_METHOD                Sets Log Method                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_MAIN_METHOD_RETURN        Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_NOTES_FLAG                Sets Note Exist and Note Count                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_PRIORITY                  Sets priority                                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_PROCESS_STATUS            Sets process status                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_RETURN                    Sets Events of Work Item                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_START_DATE                Sets Start Date                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_START_TIMESTAMP           Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_STATUS                    Sets New Status                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_STATUS_COMMITTED          Sets Status to 'COMMITTED'                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_STATUS_COMPLETED          Sets Status to 'COMPLETED' e.g. Finished Event              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_TRACE_HANDLE              Activates Trace                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_TRANSIENT_EXECUTION       Sets Flag for Transient Execution                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_VERSION_AND_EXETYP        Sets new version and execution type                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_WI_CONTAINER              Sets Work Item Container                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SET_WI_HEADER                 Sets Work Item Header                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I SIMULATE_STATUS               Simulates status change                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I UPGRADE                       Upgrade of 'Old' Work Item to Current Release               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I VALIDATE_STATUS               Checks Whether Runtime Status Matches DB Image              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I WRITE_LOG_EXCEPTION           Writes Log Entry                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_INTERNAL        I WRITE_SUCCESS                 Writes Success Message into Log                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_LOG             I DUMP_OBJ_EXCEPTION_TO_LOG     Writes exception to log                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_LOG             I SAVE                          Persists log entry                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_LOG_UTIL        I GET_PRIO_OBJECT               Determines priority object                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_ORG_UTIL        I RESOLVE_ORG_OBJECTS           Expand Org Objects to User (US)                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I COMMIT                        Commit                                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I DELETE                        Delete work item                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I DELETE_AGENTS                 Deletes agent                                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I GET_PERSISTENCE_OBJECT        Determines persistence object                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I ROLLBACK                      Rollback                                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE                          Add All Data of Work Item to Database                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_AGENTS_FOR_WORKITEM      Add Agent to Database                                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_CONTAINER                Add Work Item Container to Database                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_DEADLINES                Add Deadlines to Database                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_LOG                      Add Log Entries                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_RETURN                   Add Return Codes to Database                                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_WIHEADER                 Add Work Item Header Table to Database                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_PERS_INTERNAL   I SAVE_WORKQUEUE                Add Work Queue                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_CHILD_FLOWS               Determines child workflows                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_CHILD_ITEMS               Determines Child Work Items                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_DEADLINE_ITEMS            Determines Deadline Items                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_DEPENDANT_ITEMS           Determines All Dependent Work Items                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_DEPENDANT_WORKITEMS       Determines All Dependent Work Items                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_ITEMS                     Determines work item of workflow                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_OBJECTS                   Determines application objects                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_QUERY           I GET_PARENT_FLOWS              Determines old parent workflows                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_REMOTE_SERVICE  I GET_INSTANCE                  Gets a Service Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_REMOTE_SERVICE  I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets Container (with Transfer Parameters)                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_RESULT_INTERNAL I COMPUTE_START_TIMESTAMP       Calculates start time stamp for processing in external cont..
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_SRV_INTERNAL    I SET_DEF_GUID                  Sets Definition Guid for Work Item                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_STATE           I EXECUTE_STATE_TRANSITION      Executes Status Transfer                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_STATE           I GET_FINAL_STATES              Gets final status                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_STATE           I SET_NEW_STATE                 Sets New Status                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_STATE           I SET_TRANSACTION_MANAGER       Sets transaction manager                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_TICKET          I CREATE_AND_SET_TICKET         Generates ticket and sets generated ticket in cont.         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_TICKET          I CREATE_TICKET                 Generates ticket                                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_TICKET          I GET_TICKET                    Gets ticket                                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTIL            I DELETE_DEPENDANT_WORKITEMS    Deletes all dependent work items                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTIL            I ENQ_DEPENDANT_WORKITEMS       Lock All Dependent Work Items (Using TOP_WIID)              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTIL            I ENQ_PARENT_FLOWS              Lock All Parent Workflows                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTIL            I GET_ACTIVITY_GROUP_AGENTS     Determine User from Activity Group                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Checks Authorization for Activity on Work Item              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I GET_DEPENDANT_WIS             Searches for All Subitems of Work Item                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I GET_EXECUTION_TIME            Determines Execution Time in Seconds                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I GET_SYSTEM_USER               Determines WF BATCH - User                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I RAISE_EXCEPTION               Creates an Exception                                        .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_UTL_INTERNAL    I SET_EXCEPTION_OBJECT          Sets Exception Object for Commit Control                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WAPI            I GET_HEADER                    Supplies Work Item Header                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WAPI            I GET_HEADER_DETAIL             Gets work item header (detailed information)                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WAPI            I GET_STATUS                    Supplies Status                                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I COMPLETE_VIA_LOCAL_EVENT      Complete a Work Item Using a Local Event                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I DEQUEUE                       Unlocks Work Item                                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I ENQUEUE                       Locks the Work Item                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I EXCEPTION_TO_LOG              Writes an Exception to the Workflow Log                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_CB_DONE                   Reads Callback Flag                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_CONTEXT                   Gets Context of Work Item                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_CREATION_TIMESTAMP        Gets Creation Time-Stamp                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_EXECUTE_VIA_TRFC          Checks Whether Work Item Is Executed by tRFC                .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_MAIN_METHOD_RETURN        Gets Return Value of Main Method                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_NODEID                    Gets Node Number in Workflow Definition                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_PARFOREACH_INDEX          Gets Current ParForEach Index of Work Item                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_PRS_PROFILE               Gets Persistence Profile of Work Item Container             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_RESULT                    Gets result of work item execution                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_RHTEXT                    Gets Task Text of Work Item                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_START_NODEID              Gets Start Node Number                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_SYNC_BEFORE_EXEC          Checks Whether Commit Is Required Before Execution          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_TASK                      Gets Work Item Task                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_TASK_HANDLE               Gets Task Handle of Work Item                               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WFM_EXEC_POSSIBLE         Checks Whether WFM Can Execute Work Item                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WFTYPE                    Gets Workflow Type                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WIID                      Delivers the Work Item ID                                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WITYPE                    Gets Work Item Type                                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_CONTAINER              Gets Reference to Work Item Container                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_CREATOR                Gets Work Item Creator                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_DISABLE                Gets Lock Indicator for Work Item                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_HIERARCHY              Gets Work Item IDs of Higher-Level Work Items               .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_PRIORITY               Gets Work Item Priority                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_RELEASE                Gets Creation Release of Work Item                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_STATUS                 Gets Current Status of Work Item                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WI_WFDKEY                 Gets Definition GUID of Workflow                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I GET_WLC_FLAGS                 Gets WLC Flag for WI Header                                 .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I MERGE_ATTACHMENTS             Merges Attachment in Flow Item Container                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I RESET_PARKED_EVENTS           Resets 'Parked Events' Bit                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_CB_DONE                   Sets Callback Flag for Work Item                            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Work Item Context                                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_CREATION_TIMESTAMP        Sets Creation Time-Stamp                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_PARKED_EVENTS             Sets "Parked Events" Bit                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_PRIORITY                  Sets Work Item Priority                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_RESTART_STATUS            Sets Status for Restart                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_CANCELLED          Sets Status of Work Item to 'CANCELLED'                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_COMPLETED          Sets Status of Work Item to 'COMPLETED'                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_ERROR              Sets Status of Work Item to 'ERROR'                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_EXCPCAUGHT         Sets Status of Block Item to 'EXCPCAUGHT'                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_EXCPHANDLR         Sets Status of Block Item to 'EXCPHANDLR'                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_STATUS_STARTED            Sets Status of Work Item to 'STARTED'                       .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SET_WI_CONTAINER              Sets Work Item Container                                    .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WFM             I SUCCESS_TO_LOG                Writes Success Message to Workflow Log                      .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_CREATE_AI_ENTRIES          Generates entries for work queue (on generation)            .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_APPEND             Append a Line to an Existing Work Queue                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_DELETE             Delete a Line from an Existing Work Queue                   .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_GET                Read a Line from an Existing Work Queue                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_LIST_UPDATE        Update Element List of Work Queue                           .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_OBJECT_DISPLAY     Display Object of Entry                                     .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_STATUS_CHANGE      Change Status of Line of Work Queue                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_ELEMENT_WORKITEM_DISPLAY   Display Work Item of Entry                                  .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_EXECUTE                    Execute Work Queue                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_GET_ELEMENT_LIST           Gets element list of work queue                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_GET_WI_HANDLE              Gets work item                                              .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_HANDLE_APPLIC_EXECUTION    Handles error from application exit                         .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_RELEASE                    Release Work Queue                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_RESTART                    Restart Work Queue                                          .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_SET_ELEMENT_LIST           Sets Element List of a Worklist                             .
IF_SWF_RUN_WIM_WORK_QUEUE      I AI_SET_STATUS                 Sets status of work queue                                   .
IF_SWF_SLS_CHECK_CHANGES       I CHECK_DEADLINE_CHANGES        Check Deadline Changes                                      .
IF_SWF_SLS_CHECK_DELETION      I CHECK_DEADLINE_DELETIONS      Check Deadline Deletions                                    .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I CREATE_BY_APPL_KEY            Generate Deadline Object Using Its Application Key          .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I CREATE_BY_GUID                Generate Deadline Object Using Its GUID                     .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_APPLICATION               Gets ID of application                                      .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_APPLICATION_KEY           Gets deadline key of application                            .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_CALLBACK_CLASS            Gets callback class of deadline                             .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_DATA_CONTAINER            Gets instance for data container of deadline                .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_GROUPING1                 Gets first grouping character                               .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_GROUPING2                 Gets second grouping character                              .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_GUID                      Gets Appointment GUID                                       .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_PRIO                      Gets priority of deadline                                   .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_RETRY_COUNT               Gets number of callback attempts                            .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_STATUS                    Gets deadline status                                        .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Gets time (UTC) to be monitored                             .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I IS_ACTIVE                     Gets activity of deadline (active = 'X')                    .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I IS_PERIODIC                   Indicates whether periodic deadline                         .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I REFRESH                       Refresh Deadline Data (Current Database Data)               .
IF_SWF_SLS_DEADLINE            I SET_TIME_STAMP                Sets time stamp for deadline object (not in DB)             .
IF_SWF_SLS_DL_CALCULATION      I GET_NEXT_DEADLINE             Calculate Time Stamp of Next Deadline                       .
IF_SWF_SLS_DL_CALLBACK         I CALLBACK                      Executes callback for an overdue deadline                   .
IF_SWF_SLS_DL_CALLBACKS        I CALLBACK                      Executes the callback for the deadlines                     .
IF_SWF_SLS_DL_PACKAGES         I PACK_DEADLINES                Bundle Deadlines into Processing Packages                   .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I CREATE_BY_DEADLINES           Generate Iterator Using Deadline Object List                .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_COUNT                     Number of Objects                                           .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_CURRENT                   Current Object                                              .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_FIRST                     First Object                                                .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_LAST                      Last Object                                                 .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_NEXT                      Next Object                                                 .
IF_SWF_SLS_ITERATOR            I GET_PREVIOUS                  Previous Object                                             .
IF_SWF_SRV_CB                  I HANDLE_CALLBACK               Callback Handler for External Services                      .
IF_SWF_SRV_URL                 I GET_URL                       Fetches a Service URL                                       .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I DELETE_DATA                   Delete Trace Data Entries                                   .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I DELETE_FILTER                 Delete Selection Filter Entries                             .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I DESERIALIZE_SELECT_OPTIONS    Deserialize Select Options for Runtime Filter               .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I ENTRY_WRITE                   Write a Trace Data Entry                                    .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I GET_CTX_STRUCT_NAME           Get Name of Application Context Structure                   .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I GET_DATA_TABLE_NAME           Get Name of Trace Data Table                                .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I GET_EXT_STRUCT_NAME           Get Name of Header Extension Structure                      .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I GET_FILTER_TABLE_NAME         Get Name of Trace Filter Table                              .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I GET_OPT_STRUCT_NAME           Get Name of Structure for Select Options                    .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I INSERT_FILTER                 Add Selection Filter Entries                                .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I SELECT_DATA                   Select Trace Data Entries                                   .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I SELECT_FILTER                 Read Selection Filter Entries                               .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I SELECT_HEADERS                Select Trace Headers that Match Filter                      .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I SELECT_IDS                    Get Trace IDs that Match Filter                             .
IF_SWF_TRC_APPLICATION         I SERIALIZE_SELECT_OPTIONS      Serialize Select Options for Runtime Filter                 .
IF_SWF_TRC_CALLBACK            I DATA_REQUEST                  Callback in Tracing Application: Request Trace Data         .
IF_SWF_TRC_CONT_PERSISTENCE    I DELETE_BY_TRACE_ID            Delete All Trace Containers for a Physical Trace ID         .
IF_SWF_TRC_CONT_PERSISTENCE    I DELETE_BY_TRACE_IDS           Delete All Trace Containers for Specified Trace IDs         .
IF_SWF_TRC_DISPLAY             I CREATE_TRACE                  Call Dialog "Create Trace"                                  .
IF_SWF_TSI                     I COMMIT_WORK                   Executes COMMIT WORK (including checks)                     .
IF_SWF_TSI                     I CREATE_SUBSEQUENT_TRANSACTION Creates a subsequent transaction                            .
IF_SWF_TSI                     I CREATE_TRANSACTION            Creates a new transaction                                   .
IF_SWF_TSI                     I DISCARD                       Destructor                                                  .
IF_SWF_TSI                     I DISCARD_TRANSACTION           Rejects transaction                                         .
IF_SWF_TSI_CONFIGURABLE        I DISCARD                       Destructor                                                  .
IF_SWF_TSI_CONFIGURABLE        I INIT                          Initialization with Transaction Context                     .
IF_SWF_TSI_CONFIGURABLE        I REFRESH                       Called at start of a new transaction                        .
IF_SWF_TSI_INSTANCE_BASED      I SET_INSTID                    Initializes Service Provider with Instance ID               .
IF_SWF_TSI_PERSISTABLE         I AFTER_COMMIT                  Write-to successful                                         .
IF_SWF_TSI_PERSISTABLE         I AFTER_REJECTED_SAVE           Write-to not successful                                     .
IF_SWF_TSI_PERSISTABLE         I SAVE                          Write Persistent Status to Database                         .
IF_SWF_TSI_ROLLBACK_LISTENER   I ON_ROLLBACK                   Is called when the transaction is rolled back               .
IF_SWF_TSI_TIMEOUT_CONTROLLING I SET_TIMEOUT_SERVICE           Setting timeout service that is to be called regularly      .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION         I GET_STATUS                    Gets status of transaction                                  .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT I GET_DATABASE_CONNECTION       Gets Name of Database Connection                            .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT I GET_SERVICE_PROVIDER          Gets a Service Provider Instance                            .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT I GET_TRANSACTION_ID            Gets ID of Valid Transaction                                .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT I GET_UPDATE_MODE               Gets Update Mode of Transaction                             .
IF_SWF_TSI_TRANSACTION_CONTEXT I REGISTER                      Registers a persistent object                               .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_API          I ANALYSE_TEST_WORKFLOW         Analyse test workflow                                       .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_API          I EXECUTE_TEST                  Execute test                                                .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_API          I GET_EVENT_LOG                 Event log                                                   .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_API          I PREPARE_TEST_WORKFLOW         Prepare test workflow                                       .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_API          I TERMINATE_TEST_WORKFLOW       Terminate test workflow                                     .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_EXIT         I HAS_EXCEPTION_THROWN          Exception was thrown                                        .
IF_SWF_TST_WFUNIT_EXIT         I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_SWF_TXT_OBJECT              I GET_MIMETYPE                  Gets the MIME Type                                          .
IF_SWF_TXT_OBJECT              I GET_PROPERTY                  Gets the content of an attribute (using name)               .
IF_SWF_TXT_OBJECT              I GET_TEXT                      Returns the text as CHARACTER                               .
IF_SWF_TXT_OBJECT              I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets the content of an attribute (using name)               .
IF_SWF_TXT_OBJECT              I SET_TEXT                      Sets the text as CHARACTER                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_AGENTS              I CREATE                        Creats Agent Instance (Factory)                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_AGENTS              I CREATE_FROM_WF_DEFINITION     Create Agent Instance from Workflow Definition              .
IF_SWF_UTL_AGENTS              I EVALUATE                      Determine Agent                                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_AGENTS              I GET_AGENTS                    Get Agent                                                   .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMMAND             I EXECUTE                       Execution of Command                                        .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMP_UNDO           I CLEAR_ALL                     Initialize Undo-Stack                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMP_UNDO           I REDO                          Restore                                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMP_UNDO           I ROLLBACK_STATE                Rollback to Specified Status                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMP_UNDO           I SAVE_STATE                    Save Current Status                                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_COMP_UNDO           I UNDO                          Undo                                                        .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_DATE                      Date in Time Zone of Current User                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_DATE_UTC                  Date in GMT                                                 .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_TIME                      Time in Time Zone of Current User                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_TIMEIO                    Date/Time                                                   .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_TIMESTAMPL                Time stamp                                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_TIME_UTC                  Time in GMT                                                 .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I GET_ZONLO                     Gets Current Time Zone                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I REFRESH                       Create Time Stamp                                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I SET_DATE_AND_TIME             Sets Date and Time (Current Time Zone)                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I SET_DATE_AND_TIME_UTC         Sets Date and Time (UTC Time Zone)                          .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I SET_TIMESTAMPL                Sets Time Stamp (Long)                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I SET_USER                      Sets User                                                   .
IF_SWF_UTL_DATE_SERVICES       I SET_ZONLO                     Sets Timezone                                               .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_END               Read required end date                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_END_AGENT         Read agent for required end date                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_END_METHOD        Read method for required end date                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_START             Read required start date                                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_START_AGENT       Read agents for required start date                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_DESIRED_START_METHOD      Read method for required start date                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_END                Read required end date                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_END_AGENT          Read agents for latest end date                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_END_METHOD         Read method for latest end date                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_START              Read latest start date                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_START_AGENT        Read agent for latest start date                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I GET_LATEST_START_METHOD       Read method for latest start date                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_END               Set required end date                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_END_AGENT         Set agents for required end date                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_END_METHOD        Set method for required end date                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_START             Set required start date                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_START_AGENT       Set agent for required start date                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_DESIRED_START_METHOD      Set method for required start date                          .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_END                Set latest end date                                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_END_AGENT          Set agent for latest end date                               .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_END_METHOD         Set method for latest end date                              .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_START              Set latest start date                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_START_AGENT        Set agent for latest start date                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_DEADLINE_OBJECT     I SET_LATEST_START_METHOD       Set method for latest start date                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_DL_MONITORED_OBJ    I SIGNAL_DEADLINE               Notify object when deadline is reached                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_GENERIC_SERVICES    I GET_TASK_GROUP                Determines Task Group for Workflow Start                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I ADD_DELETION                  Add a newly deleted instance                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I ADD_INSTANCE                  Add a new instance                                          .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I CLEAR_DELETION_TAB            Delete table of deleted instances                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I CLEAR_INSTANCE_TAB            Delete table of instances                                   .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I DELETE_DELETION               Delete an instance from table of deleted instances          .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete an instance from instance table                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I GET_DELETION_TAB              Read table of deleted instances                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I GET_INSTANCE_BY_OID           Read an instance from instance table                        .
IF_SWF_UTL_GEN_INSTANCE_MGR    I GET_INSTANCE_TAB              Read table of instances                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_GUI_COMP_CHECK      I CHECK                         Check all data                                              .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_ARCHIVE_CLASSNAME         Implements the archive connection                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_BUSINESS_CLASSNAME        Get business object type                                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_BUS_KEY                   Gets unique Id of instance                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_CATID                     Gets object category of business class                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_INSTID                    Gets instance key (IBFLocal)                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_OWN_CLASSNAME             Gets class name of current instance                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_PERSISTENCE_CLASSNAME     Implements persistence interface                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_REPORTING_CLASSNAME       Implements reporting interface(s)                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_INTROSPECTION       I GET_RUNTIME_CLASSNAME         Do not use -" GET_BUSINESS_CLASSNAME                        .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SEND                          Send Mail                                                   .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_BODY                      Body of Mail                                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_FUNCTION                  Function Module                                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_LANGUAGE                  Language                                                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_NAME                      Name of Mail                                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_OWNER                     Owner                                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_PARAMETER                 Parameters for Function                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_RECEIVERS                 Set Receiver                                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_REQUESTER                 Sets mail requester                                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_SENDER                    Sender                                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_TASK                      Task for Title + Body                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_TITLE                     Title of Mail                                               .
IF_SWF_UTL_MAIL                I SET_WORKITEM                  Set Work Item Handle                                        .
IF_SWF_UTL_MULTI_EXEC          I GET_DETAILED_STATUS           Gets Detailed Multiexec Status                              .
IF_SWF_UTL_MULTI_EXEC          I GET_STATUS                    Gets the multiexec status of a work item                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_MULTI_EXEC          I UPDATE_RESULT                 Result of WI execution processed according to status        .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I DELETE_FROM_DATABASE          Delete Object Data (during SAVE_TO_DATABASE* later)         .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I GET_IBF_POR_OF_INSTANCE       IBF Local POR of current instance                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I GET_INSTANCE_BY_KEY           Instantiation of Object                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I GET_POR_OF_INSTANCE           POR of Current Instance                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I INSERT_INTO_DATABASE          Insert Object Data (during SAVE_TO_DATABASE* later)         .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I LOAD_FROM_DATABASE            Load Object Data                                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I SAVE_TO_DATABASE              Write Object Data to Corresponding DB Tables                .
IF_SWF_UTL_PERSISTENT_OBJECT   I SAVE_TO_DATABASE_ALL          Write data of all object instances to DB                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets (language-dependent) description of this operator      .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I GET_ICON                      Gets graphical icon for this operator                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I GET_NAME                      Gets unique name for DISPLAY of this operator               .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I GET_SYMBOL                    Gets unique INTERNAL name for this operator                 .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I GET_TEXT_KEY                  Gets SE61 key for long text of this operator                .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I TO_HTML                       Get HTML display of operator                                .
IF_SWF_UTL_PRESENTATION        I TO_STRING                     Gets string display of operator (Dynpro output)             .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I ACTIVATE_COMMIT_LOG           Activate Log for Commit                                     .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I COMMIT                        Executes DB Commit or Commit Work                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I GET_ACTIVE_WORKITEM           Read Current Work Item                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I GET_COMMIT_LOG                Log for Commit Active                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I GET_COMMMIT_WORK_CONTROL      Read 'Commit Work' Control                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I PASSIVATE_COMMIT_LOG          Passive Log for Commit                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I REMOVE                        Deletes Current Transaction                                 .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I ROLLBACK                      Executes Rollback                                           .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I SET_ACTIVE_WORKITEM           Sets Current Work Item                                      .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I SET_COMMMIT_WORK_CONTROL      Sets 'Commit Work' Control                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Transaction Context                                    .
IF_SWF_UTL_TRANSACTION         I SET_TRFC_EXECUTED             Sets Property for tRFC Execution                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I GET_INITIAL_TRACE_DATA        Gets Initial Container for Trace                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I GET_LAST_EXCEPTION            Gets Last Error                                             .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I GET_MESSAGE_OBJECT            Factory for Message Object                                  .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I GET_PARAMETER_CONTAINER       Parameter Container for Function                            .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I REGISTER_FUNCTION             API Register (Function Module)                              .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I REGISTER_METHOD               Register API (Method)                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I SET_ACTUAL_LANGUAGE           Sets Current Language                                       .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I SET_COMMIT_CONTROL            Sets Commit Control                                         .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I UNREGISTER                    Deregister API                                              .
IF_SWF_UTL_WAPI_FRAMEWORK      I WRITE_TRACE                   Write Trace                                                 .
IF_SWF_WAPI_EVENT              I CREATE                        Create Event                                                .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKFLOW           I START                         Start Workflow                                              .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I CHANGE_PRIORITY               Change Work Item Priority                                   .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I DISPLAY                       Display Work Item with Dialog Interface                     .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I EXECUTE                       Execute Work Item with Dialog Interface                     .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I EXECUTE_EXTERNALLY            Execute Work Item Without Dialog Interface                  .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I FORWARD                       Forward work item                                           .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I PUT_BACK                      Replace work item                                           .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_ATTACHMENTS              Read Attachments (as References) of Work Items              .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_ATTACHMENT_CONTENTS      Read Content of a Work Item Attachment                      .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_CONTAINER                Read Work Item Container                                    .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_DEADLINES                Read Deadline Data of Work Item                             .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_DESCRIPTION              Read Description (Task Long Text) of Work Item              .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_FORWARD_TO               Read user to whom work item can be forwarded                .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_HEADER                   Read header (most important,cheapest attribute) of work item.
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_METHODS                  Read Methods of Work Item                                   .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_OBJECTS                  Read Object References of Work Item                         .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I READ_RECIPIENTS               Read Work Item Receiver                                     .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I REJECT                        Reject Work Item                                            .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I RESERVE                       Reserve Work Item                                           .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I SET_TO_DONE                   Set Work Item to "Completed"                                .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I UPDATE_ATTACHMENT_CONTENTS    Update Contents of a Work Item Attachment                   .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKITEM           I WRITE_CONTAINER               Write Work Item Container                                   .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKLIST           I COUNT_WORKITEMS               Read Work Item Number for a User                            .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKLIST           I CREATE                        Read Worklist for a User                                    .
IF_SWF_WAPI_WORKLIST           I READ_MULTI_EXEC_GUID          Read GUI of Execution Block for Mass Execution              .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I ADD_COMPONENT_INSTANCE        Adds a component to instance management                     .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I COMPLETE_CHILDLIST            Completes list of child components                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I CREATE_COMPONENT_ITERATOR     Generates an iterator using components                      .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I REGISTER_PERS_COMP            Registers a persistent object                               .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I UNREGISTER                    Removes transferred component from instance management      .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_COMPONENT  I UNREGISTER_PERS_COMP          Deregisters a persistent object                             .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I CHECK_NODE_IN_CONTEXT         Checks that node belongs to context                         .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I CLEANUP                       Cleanup Point                                               .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I CREATE_COMPONENT_ITERATOR     Generates an iterator using components                      .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I CREATE_LOCAL_FLOW             Generates a new component for a WFD node                    .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_CB_COMPONENT             Loads component for work item to be recalled                .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_DEBUG_COMPONENT          Loads component for restart                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_FLOW_COMPONENT           Loads component for flow item                               .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_RESTART_COMPONENT        Loads component for restart                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_STARTING_COMPONENT       Loads component for work item to be started                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I LOAD_WIM_CONTEXT              Loads component hierarchy using WIM object                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I PROCESS_NODE                  Generates a new component for a WFD node                    .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I SET_TRACE_HANDLE              Sets a logical trace handle                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_CMP_FACT_WFM        I SYNC                          Sync Point                                                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I CANCEL                        Cancel Request                                              .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I CAST_WIM_COMPONENT            CAST to Interface IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I DESTROY                       Destructor                                                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_CONTAINER                 Container own WIM object or next highest-level              .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_GUID                      Gets GUID of component                                      .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_LOOP_INDEX                Gets loop index of component                                .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_NEXT_LOOP_COUNTER         Gets current loop counter of next loop                      .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_NEXT_NODE_STRATEGY        Gets NEXT_NODE strategy handle                              .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_NODEID                    Gets ID of (start) node                                     .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_PARENT                    Gets parent object                                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_PARFOREACH                Gets next ParForEach component in hierarchy                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_PARFOREACH_INDEX          Gets ParForEach index of component                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I GET_WIM_CONTEXT               Determines next complex WIM component                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I HAS_CHILD                     Checks whether transferred GUID is a child component        .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I LOG_EXCEPTION                 Writes an exception to SWWLOGHIST                           .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I RETRY_SET_FINAL_STATES        Repeats setting work item to final status                   .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I SET_PARENT                    Sets parent of component                                    .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I SET_STARTING_FLAG             Flags the component as started                              .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I SET_SUSPEND_ERRORTYPE         Sets error type for suspend                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT           I SYNC                          Synchronization Point                                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_ITERATOR  I GET_NEXT                      Gets next component                                         .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I ADD                           Adds data                                                   .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I GET_COMPONENT_GUID            Gets/generates GUID of corresponding component              .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I GET_NODEID                    Gets ID of start node of corresponding component            .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I GET_PARFOREACH_INDEX          Gets ParForEach index of corresponding component            .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I ON_COMPONENT_DESTROY          Called when corresponding component started                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I ON_COMPONENT_ROLLBACK         Called when corresponding component started                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_PERSIST   I SYNC                          Sync Point                                                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I COMPLETE_VIA_LOCAL_EVENT      Cancels wait steps waiting for local events                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I GET_RESULT                    Gets result of work item execution                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I GET_TASK_HANDLE               Gets task handle (if available)                             .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I GET_WIID                      Delivers the Work Item ID                                   .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I SET_ERROR_TO_LOG              Writes error to log list                                    .
IF_SWF_WFM_COMPONENT_WIM       I SET_OBSOLETE                  Sets work item to obsolete                                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I CHECK                         Dispatcher for All Further Methods                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I DEBUG                         Debugging                                                   .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I EXECUTE                       Contains actual execution of component                      .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I FINALIZE                      Contains callback processing                                .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I HANDLE_DEADLINE               Deadline Handling                                           .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I HANDLE_ERROR                  Handling of Work Item Execution with Errors                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I PREPARE                       Prepares execution                                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_LEAF_EXECUTE        I RESTART                       Restart After Error                                         .
IF_SWF_WFM_SVC_CNT_HELPER      I MAKE_PERSISTABLE              Conversion of a runtime container to a persistable Container.
IF_SWF_WFM_SVC_METH_HELPER     I GET_METHOD_CONTAINER          Gets Methods-Container for Given Method                     .
IF_SWF_WFM_SVC_OBJECTS         I RETRIEVE_USED_OBJECTS         Gets objects used in last call                              .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I CHECK_DEADLINE_MODELLED       Checks whether a particular deadline is modeled             .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_BINDING_DATAFLOW          Gets direction of binding for binding                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_BINDING_DEFINITION        Gets binding definition                                     .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_BLOCKTYPE                 Gets type of block (for block items)                        .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_CALLBACK_FB               Gets name of callback function module                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_CALLED_IN_BACKGROUND      Gets "called in background" indicator                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_COMPLETION_EVENTS         Gets terminating event of step                              .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_CONTEXT_CONTAINER         Gets container of current context                           .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_CREATION_PARAMETERS       Gets additional create parameters                           .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_FLOW_HANDLE               Gets handle of workflow                                     .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_LANGUAGE                  Gets language of workflow                                   .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_LINK_CONTEXT_AS_PARENT    Do you want to link the context container as parent?        .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_MAX_SUBWF_LEVEL           Gets maximum subflow level                                  .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_PARFOREACH_INDEX          Gets ParForEach index                                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_PART_OF_DIALOG_BLOCK      Gets Part of a Dialog Block                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_PERSISTENCY_PROFILE       Gets persistence profile                                    .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_REJECTABLE                Gets "rejectable" indicator                                 .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_SOURCE_CONTAINER          Gets source container for binding                           .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_STEP_HANDLE               Gets a runtime object of current step                       .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_SUSPEND_DATA              Gets data for the suspend entry                             .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_TASK                      Gets task ID                                                .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_USER                      Gets user of current context                                .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_WFDKEY                    Gets WFD key                                                .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_WFM_FOR_START             Gets a WFM at start of flow item                            .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_WFTYPE                    Gets workflow type                                          .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_WITYPE                    Gets work item type                                         .
IF_SWF_WFM_WIM_REQUEST         I GET_WI_HIERARCHY              Gets higher-level WI IDs                                    .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I DEFINITIONS_SELECTED          Query Whether Definitions Are Selected                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I DELETE_SELECTED_DEFINITIONS   Deletes the Selected Definitions from the Database          .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I FILL_CALLMODE_LISTBOX         POV Method: Fills the Callmode Listbox                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I FREE                          Destructor                                                  .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I GET_CLASSNAME                 Delivers the Class Name of the Controller Instance          .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I GET_DYNPRO_FIELDS             Delivers the Current Screen Fields                          .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I GET_NEXT_DYNNR                Delivers the Number of the Next Screen                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I GET_PREVIOUS_DYNNR            Delivers the Number of the Last Screen                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I GET_TASK_GENERATOR            Delivers a Task Generator Instance                          .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I HAS_XSLT_MESSAGES             Gives Info. Regarding Whether XSLT Messages Are Available   .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I LOAD_PORT                     Loads a Port Definition from the Database                   .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I PAI                           Process After Input                                         .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I PAI_231                       PAI for Screen 231                                          .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I PBO                           Process Before Output                                       .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SAVE                          Saves All Changes Made                                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SAVE_PORT                     Saves a Port Definition on the Database                     .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SET_DYNNR                     Notifies the Number of Screens Present                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SET_DYNPRO_FIELDS             Notifies the Content of the Screen Fields                   .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SET_FILEPATH                  Sets a New WSDL Source Path                                 .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SET_NEXT_DYNNR                Sets Number of Next Screen from Outside                     .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I SET_SELECTION                 Sets New Definition Selection                               .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I TOGGLE_CHANGE_MODE            Switches Between Change Mode and Display Mode               .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I UPDATE_IMPLEMENTATION_BASE    Update of Binding Basis Informationen                       .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I UPDATE_IMPLEMENTATION_DETAIL  Update of Binding Detail Information                        .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I UPDATE_INTERFACE_BASE         Update of Interface Basis Information                       .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I UPDATE_INTERFACE_DETAIL       Update of Interface Detail Information                      .
IF_SWF_WSD_CTRL_DYNP           I UPDATE_PORT_DETAIL            Update of Port Detail Information                           .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I BUILD_REQUEST                 Creates an HTTP Request                                     .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I DIGEST_CALLBACK_REQUEST       Processing HTTP callback                                    .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I DIGEST_NAME_VALUE_PAIRS       Processing name-value pair as parameter                     .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I DIGEST_RESPONSE               Processing HTTP response                                    .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_MESSAGE_KIND              Delivers Type of Message (Input, Output, Fault)             .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_MESSAGE_STRING            Delivers String Representation of Message                   .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_NAME                      Delivers Name of Message                                    .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_PART                      Delivers Message Part                                       .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_PART_ITERATOR             Delivers Iterator About the Message Parts                   .
IF_SWF_WSI_MESSAGE             I GET_PART_NAME_LIST            Delivers List of all Message Part Names                     .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_ABAPTYPE                  Delivers the ABAP Type of the Message Part                  .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_CONTDEF                   Delivers CONTDEF Structure                                  .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_NAME                      Delivers the Name of the Message Part                       .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_PROPERTIES                Reads the Properties                                        .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_URLENCODED_NVP            Delivers Name Value Pair urlEncoded                         .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_URLENCODED_STRING         Delivers Value of Message Part URL-Encoded (If Possible)    .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_VALUE_IF                  Delivers the Value in Internal ABAP Format                  .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_VALUE_REF                 Delivers ABAP Value as Data Reference                       .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_VALUE_REF_CNT             Delivers ABAP Value as Data Reference for Container         .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_XMLTYPE                   Delivers the XML Types of the Part                          .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I GET_XML_VALUE                 Delivers the Value in the XML Format                        .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I SET_PROPERTIES                Sets the Properties                                         .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I SET_VALUE                     Sets Value of Message Part                                  .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I SET_VALUE_REF                 Sets the Value Using the Data Reference                     .
IF_SWF_WSI_PART                I SET_XML_VALUE                 Sets the Value as XML String                                .
IF_SWF_WSI_PORT                I EXECUTE                       Start Service                                               .
IF_SWF_WSI_PORT_FACTORY        I CREATE_PORT                   Port Factory                                                .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I REMOVE_INVALID_DEFINITIONS    Deletes Definitions that Were Imported in Error             .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_IMPLEMENTATION_ASYNC      Sets ASYNC Property of an Implementation                    .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_IMPLEMENTATION_CALLBACK   Sets CALLBACK Property for Available Implementation         .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_IMPLEMENTATION_SAPNAME    Sets the Name of Binding                                    .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_INTERFACE_DIALOG          Sets DIALOG Property for Available Interface                .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_INTERFACE_SPONAME         Sets SPONAME for Available Interface                        .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_PORT_ADDRESS              Sets the Address of a Port                                  .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_EDIT          I SET_PORT_SAPNAME              Sets the SAP Name of a Port                                 .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I CHECK_ANY_CHANGED             Checks if One of the Definitions Has Changed                .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I CHECK_IMPORT_SELECTION        Checks Whether Selection May Be Imported                    .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I DELETE_SELECTION              Deletes the Selection from the Database                     .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I IMPORT_SELECTION              Imports Selection                                           .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I LOAD_PORT                     Loads Port Definition                                       .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I SAVE                          Saves Everything                                            .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I SAVE_PORT                     Saves a Port Definition                                     .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I SET_CHANGE_MODE               Sets Change Mode Collectively                               .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I SET_DELETE_SELECTION          Sets Selection That Is to Be Deleted                        .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_PERSISTENCE   I SET_IMPORT_SELECTION          Sets Selection That Is to Be Imported                       .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_DEFINITIONS               Delivers Definitions (Interfaces, Implementations, Ports)   .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_FIRST_INTERFACE           Delivers the First Interface                                .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_IMPLEMENTATION            Delivers Implementation                                     .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_IMPLEMENTATIONS           Delivers All Implementations (Optional to Determine INTFID) .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_INTERFACE                 Delivers Interface                                          .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_INTERFACES                Delivers all Interfaces                                     .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_PORT                      Delivers Port                                               .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_PORTS                     Delivers all Service Ports (Optional for INTFID and IMPLID) .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_PORTTYPES                 Delivers WSDL Port Types (Optional for Service)             .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_SERVICES                  Delivers WSDL Services                                      .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I GET_XSLT_MESSAGES             Delivers XSLT Messages                                      .
IF_SWF_WSP_WSDEF_QUERY         I INTERFACE_HAS_OUTPUT          Has Interface Output Message?                               .
IF_SWF_WSS_DISPATCHER_LOCAL    I HANDLE_REQUEST                Local Request Handler                                       .
IF_SWF_WSS_EXCEPTION_HANDLER   I HANDLE_EXCEPTION              Handles exceptions according to context and type of exceptn .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER             I HANDLE_REQUEST                Processes Request                                           .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER             I WRITE_MESSAGES                Callback Method for Writing Back Messages                   .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_ADDRESS                   Delivers Physical Address of Service                        .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_ASYNC                     Delivers Async Property of Service                          .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_CALLBACK                  Delivers Callback Property                                  .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_CALLBACK_URL              Delivers Callback URL                                       .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_CALLMODE                  Delivers the Call Mode                                      .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_CLIENT                    Delivers the HTTP Client                                    .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_CLIENTTYPE                Delivers Type of Client                                     .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_DEFRELEASE                Delivers Definition Release of Task for Work Item           .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_DIALOG                    Delivers the Dialog Property of Service                     .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_DIRECT_CALL               Delivers the "DIRECT_CALL" Indicator of Context             .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_EXCEPTION_HANDLER         Delivers Exception Handler Object                           .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_EXECGUID                  Delivers Execution GUID                                     .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_IMPLTYPE                  Delivers Type of Service Binding (HTTP, SOAP Using HTTP)    .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_LANGU                     Delivers Language Key                                       .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_LOCAL                     Delivers the "local" Indicator of Context                   .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_LOGSYS                    Delivers Logical System of the Workflow Instance            .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_PARAMETERS                Delivers the Application Data from Request                  .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_REQUEST_TYPE              Delivers Type of Request                                    .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_RFCDEST                   Delivers RFC Destination of Workflow System                 .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_SERVER                    Delivers Server Object of HTTP Session                      .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_SERVICE_DIRECTORY         Delivers Directory Containing Service Description           .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_SERVICE_IMPL              Delivers Service Implementation Object                      .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_SERVICE_INTF              Delivers Service Interface Object                           .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_TASK                      Delivers Task for the Work Item                             .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_UNAME                     Delivers User Names                                         .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I GET_WORKITEM                  Delivers Work Item Object                                   .
IF_SWF_WSS_HANDLER_CONTEXT     I SET_CLIENT                    Sets HTTP Client                                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_MESSAGE_FACTORY     I CREATE_MESSAGE                Factory Method for Messages                                 .
IF_SWF_WSS_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Message Handler Method                                      .
IF_SWF_WSS_PART_ITERATOR       I GET_NEXT                      Delivers Next Message Part                                  .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I ADD_WITEXT                    Adds Work Item Text                                         .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I GENERATE_TASK                 Generates a Task                                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I SET_LANGUAGE                  Sets the Task Generator Language                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I SET_LOGSYS                    Sets the Logical System, In Which the Task Is Generated     .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I SET_SHORT                     Sets the Task ID                                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I SET_STEXT                     Sets the Task Name                                          .
IF_SWF_WSS_TASK_GENERATOR      I SET_UNAME                     Sets User of Task Creator                                   .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I BACK                          Replaces Work Item                                          .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I COMPLETE                      Sets the Work Item to Status COMPLETED                      .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I GET_CONTAINER                 Delivers the Work Item Container                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I GET_TYPE                      Delivers Type of Work Item                                  .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I GET_WIID                      Delivers the ID of the Work Item                            .
IF_SWF_WSS_WORKITEM            I SELECT                        Selects Work Item                                           .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_LOG              I ADD_APP_LOG_MESSAGE           Adds New Message to Application Log                         .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_LOG              I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds a new message to log                                   .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_LOG              I CLEAR                         Deletes log                                                 .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_TASK             I CHECK                         Checks the status                                           .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_TASK             I EXECUTE                       Changes the status                                          .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_TASK             I GET_APPL_NAME                 Gets name of application                                    .
IF_SWF_XI_ADM_TASK             I GET_STATE                     Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_DESTINATION_URL           Delivers the URL to Which the Document Is Sent              .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_LOCAL_URL                 Delivers the URL of the Local Process Instance              .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_PROCESS_PROXY             Delivers the Proxy Object (If Available)                    .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_REMOTE_URL                Delivers the URL of Remote Process Instance                 .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_STATUS                    Delivers the Status                                         .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I GET_WI_ID                     Delivers the Work Item ID                                   .
IF_SWF_XML_CONTEXT             I SET_REMOTE_URL                Sets the URL of the Remote Process Instance                 .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_INTROSPECT  I GET_CALLBACK_URL              Gets the URL that a response is to be sent to               .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_INTROSPECT  I GET_RESPONSE_REQUIRED         Gets ResponseRequired ID from Request                       .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_INTROSPECT  I RECOGNIZE_PROTOCOL_ID         Identifies the protocol ID using the request                .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_RECEIVE     I HANDLE_REQUEST                Handles the Inbound Request                                 .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SEND        I HANDLE_RESPONSE_DATA          Processes the Response After Sending (Data)                 .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SEND        I HANDLE_RESPONSE_ENVELOPE      Processes the Reponse After Sending (Envelope)              .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SEND        I SET_REQUEST_DATA              Set Data                                                    .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SEND        I SET_REQUEST_ENVELOPE          Sets the Envelope for the XML Document                      .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SERVICE     I CONTAINER_FROM_XML            Fills Container Elements from XML Document                  .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SERVICE     I CONTAINER_TO_XML              Inserts Container Elements into XML Document                .
IF_SWF_XML_REQUEST_SERVICE     I GET_REQUEST_FUNCTION          Gets the Function for a Particular Request                  .
IF_SWF_XML_RULE_DATA_MAPPING   I PERFORM_MAPPING               Executes a Data Conversion                                  .
IF_SWF_XML_RULE_DATA_SET       I DECODE_DATA_FROM_XML          Delivers the Data from the XML Document                     .
IF_SWF_XML_RULE_DATA_SET       I ENCODE_DATA_TO_XML            Sets the Data into the XML Document                         .
IF_SWF_XML_RULE_FORMAT         I GET_FORMAT                    Delivers the Transfer Format                                .
IF_SWF_XML_RULE_URL            I GET_URL                       Delivers the URL                                            .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I CREATE_WF_START_CONTAINER     Creates Container from Workflow Import Parameters           .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I DELETE                        Delete from Database                                        .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I EDIT_DEFINITION               Edit/Display Container Definition                           .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I EDIT_VALUES                   Edit/Display Container Values                               .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I GET_CONTAINER_REF             OBSOLETE! Use GET_PARAM_CONTAINER_REF                       .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I GET_ID                        Returns GUID                                                .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I GET_PARAM_CONTAINER_REF       Gets Reference to Container                                 .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I GET_VALUE                     Returns Element Value                                       .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I GET_VALUES                    Returns Element Values (BOR Format)                         .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I HAS_MODIFIED                  Queries Whether Container has Changed                       .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I SAVE_AS_COPY                  Saves Container As Copy (New GUID)                          .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I SET_TANSPORT                  Sets Transport Object (On/Off) Customizing                  .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I SET_VALUE                     Sets Element Value                                          .
IF_SWJ_PPF_CONTAINER           I SET_VALUES                    Sets Element Values (BOR Format)                            .
IF_SWLP_WI_URL                 I GET_CALLBACK_HANDLER_URL_4_WI Creates URL to the Callback Handler                         .
IF_SWLP_WI_URL                 I GET_LAUNCH_HANDLER_URL_4_WI   Creates URL to the Launch Handler                           .
IF_SWLWP_URI                   I SERIALIZE                     Returns Object as String                                    .
IF_SWNC_AGG_MEDIATOR           I ADD_AGGREGATE                 Add an Aggregate to the Aggregate                           .
IF_SWNC_AGG_MEDIATOR           I ADD_MAIN_RECORD               Add a Statistics Record to the Aggregate                    .
IF_SWNC_AGG_MEDIATOR           I FINALIZE                      End Aggregation                                             .
IF_SWNC_AGG_MEDIATOR           I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Aggregation                                      .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_ARFC_RECEIVER     I CALL_BACK_R40                 Call Back from 4.0 - 6.40 Remote System without BI Extension.
IF_SWNC_GLOB_ARFC_RECEIVER     I CALL_BACK_R46                 Call Back from a 4.6C - 6.40 Remote System with BI Extension.
IF_SWNC_GLOB_ARFC_RECEIVER     I CALL_BACK_R70                 Call Back from a Release 7.0 Remote System                  .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER            I READ_LOCAL                    Read Data from a Local System                               .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER            I READ_REMOTE_R40               From Remote 4.0 to 6.40 Systems (without BI Extensions)     .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER            I READ_REMOTE_R46               From Remote 4.6C to 6.40 Remote Systems (with BI Extensions).
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER            I READ_REMOTE_R70               Read Data from a Remote Release 7.0 System                  .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER_LOCAL      I READ_LOCAL_R70                Local Read on a Release 7.0 System                          .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER_REMOTE     I READ_REMOTE_R40               Remote Call on SAP Web AS 6.40 (or Older) Sys. w/o BI Ext.  .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER_REMOTE     I READ_REMOTE_R46               Remote Call on SAP Web AS 6.40 (or Older) Sys. with BI Ext. .
IF_SWNC_GLOB_READER_REMOTE     I READ_REMOTE_R70               Remot Call on a 7.0 System                                  .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_ENDTIME                   Returns End Time Stamp                                      .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_MAINRECORD                Returns Structure of the Statistics Record                  .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_MANDANT                   Returns Clients                                             .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_OBJ_TYPE                  Returns Type of Statistics Record                           .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_STEP_ID                   Returns Dialog Step ID                                      .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_SUBRECS_COUNT             Number of Subrecords                                        .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_TCODE                     Returns TCode                                               .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_TRANSACTION_ID            Returns Transaction ID                                      .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_USERNAME                  Returns User Name                                           .
IF_SWNC_MAINREC                I GET_WORKPROCESS_ID            Returns Work Process ID                                     .
IF_SWNC_READER                 I FINALIZE                      End Read                                                    .
IF_SWNC_READER                 I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Read with Start Time Stamp and Time Zone  .
IF_SWNC_READER                 I READ_NEXT                     Read the Next Logical Record                                .
IF_SWNC_RECORDS_FILTER         I GET_ENDTIME                   Returns Upper Limit of Time Interval                        .
IF_SWNC_RECORDS_FILTER         I GET_STARTTIME                 Returns Lower Limit of Time Interval                        .
IF_SWNC_RECORDS_FILTER         I GET_TIMEZONE                  Outputs Timezone                                            .
IF_SWNC_RECORDS_FILTER         I RECORD_FIT                    Filters by Predefined Selection Criteria                    .
IF_SWNC_STATREC                I DO_READ                       Read Statistics Records from the Specified Time Interval    .
IF_SWNC_STATREC                I GET_MAINRECORDS               Returns Table with References to Read Statistics Records    .
IF_SWNC_STATREC                I GET_MAINRECORDS_COUNT         Returns Number of Read Statistics Records                   .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_ID                        Returns the ID of the selection Schedule                    .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_INTERVAL                  Returns the interval                                        .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_SCENARIO                  Returns the scenario                                        .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_TIME_FROM                 Returns the start time                                      .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_TIME_TO                   Returns the end time                                        .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_TIME_ZONE                 Returns the time zone                                       .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I GET_WEEKDAYS_STRUCTURE        Returns the weekday                                         .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I LOAD_INSTANCE                 Initializes object from the database                        .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_DESCRIPTION               Sets the description                                        .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_FILTER                    Sets the filter                                             .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_INTERVAL                  Sets the interval                                           .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_KEYS                      Sets the key (ID, scenario)                                 .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_LAST_MODIFIED             Sets the change time stamp                                  .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_LAST_MODIFIED_BY          Sets the last changed by user                               .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_TIME_FROM                 Sets the start time                                         .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_TIME_TO                   Sets the end time                                           .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_TIME_ZONE                 Sets the time zone                                          .
IF_SWN_ADM_COLLECTOR_SCHEDULE  I SET_WEEKDAYS                  Sets the week days                                          .
IF_SWN_CATEGORY                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Determines Description (Language-Dependent)                 .
IF_SWN_CATEGORY                I GET_MESSAGE                   Determine Message Object                                    .
IF_SWN_CATEGORY                I GET_SCENARIO                  Corresponding Scenario Object                               .
IF_SWN_COLLECTOR               I PROCESS                       Get Notifications                                           .
IF_SWN_DELIVERER               I RECALL                        Recall Message                                              .
IF_SWN_DELIVERER               I SEND                          Send message                                                .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_MAN            I PROCESS                       Message Creation and Dispatch                               .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_ID                        Returns the delivery schedule ID                            .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_INTERVAL                  Returns the interval                                        .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_LAST_APPLIED              Determines the last schedule application                    .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_LAST_INTERVAL             Determines the last interval of a schedule                  .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_TIME_FROM                 Returns the start time                                      .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_TIME_TO                   Returns the end time                                        .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_TIME_ZONE                 Returns the time zone                                       .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I GET_WEEKDAYS                  Returns the weekday                                         .
IF_SWN_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE       I SET_LAST_APPLIED              Saves the last schedule application                         .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Read Description (Language-Dependent)                       .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_LAST_APPLIED              Read Time Stamp of Last Filter Application                  .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_MAIN_FILTER_REF           Reference to Main Filter                                    .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_PREV_APPLIED              Read Time Stamp of Penultimate Filter Application           .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_SCENARIO                  Corresponding Scenario Object                               .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_VALUE                     Read Individual Filter Value with Conversion                .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_VALUES_RAW                Read List of Filter Values                                  .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I GET_VALUE_RAW                 Read Individual Filter Value Without Conversion             .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I SET_LAST_APPLIED              Set Time Stamp of Last Filter Application                   .
IF_SWN_FILTER                  I SET_PREV_APPLIED              Set Time Stamp of Penultimate Filter Application            .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I ADD_NOTIFICATIONS             Add Notifications                                           .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I BUILD                         Creates a message                                           .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_ATTACHMENT_CONTENT        Content of Specific Attachment from the List                .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_ATTACHMENT_LIST           List of Attachments (Only Header Data)                      .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_DELIVERY_TYPE_REF         Returns the reference to the quality of service             .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_DELIVER_ASAP              Deliver message immediately?                                .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_GRANULARITY               Returns the granularity of the message                      .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_NOTIFICATIONS             Returns the references to the notifications                 .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_PRIORITY                  Returns the priority of the entire message                  .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_RECIPIENT_REF             Returns the reference to the receiver                       .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_RELIABILITY               Returns the reliability for the message dispatch            .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_REPLY_ADDRESS             Determine Individual Reply Addresses                        .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I GET_SUBJECT                   Returns the subject line of the message                     .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SEND                          Send warning                                                .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_DELIVERY_TYPE_REF         Sets a reference to a quality of service                    .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_GRANULARITY               Sets the granularity of the message                         .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_RECIPIENT_REF             Sets a reference to the receiver                            .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_RELIABILITY               Sets the reliability for the message dispatch               .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_SENT_TIME                 Set the Time Stamp for the Send Log                         .
IF_SWN_MESSAGE                 I SET_SUBJECT                   Sets the subject line of the message                        .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_ATTACHMENT_CONTENT        Content of Attachments                                      .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_ATTACHMENT_LIST           List of Attachments (Only Header Data)                      .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_BODY                      Core for Message                                            .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_CATEGORY_REF              Reference to Category                                       .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_HAS_ACTION_ATTACHMENT     Does the notification have action attachments?              .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_LAST_SENT                 Information on Last Send                                    .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_LINKS                     List of URLs                                                .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_SCENARIO_REF              Reference to Scenario                                       .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_SUBJECT                   Message Subject                                             .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_SUBSCRIPTION_REF          Determine Reference to Subscription                         .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I GET_USER_REF                  Determine Reference to User                                 .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I SET_LAST_SENT                 Set Information on Last Send                                .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I SET_STATUS_DELETED            Sets the status 'deleted'                                   .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I SET_STATUS_DELIVERED          Sets the status 'sent'                                      .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I SET_SUBSCRIPTION_REF          Set Reference to Subscription                               .
IF_SWN_NOTIF                   I SET_USER_REF                  Set Reference to User                                       .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_CATEGORY                  Generate Object for Category                                .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_DELIVERER                 Generate Deliverer for Quality of Service                   .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_DELIVERY_SCHEDULE         Generate Object for a Delivery Schedule                     .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_DELIVERY_TYPE             Generate Object for Quality of Service                      .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_FILTER                    Generate Object for Filter                                  .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_MESSAGE                   Generate Object for a Message                               .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_NOTIF                     Generate Object for Notification                            .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_SCENARIO                  Generate Object for Scenario                                .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_SUBSCRIPTION              Generate Object for Subscription                            .
IF_SWN_OBJECT_FACTORY          I GET_USER_CLASSNAME            Determine Class Name for User Handler                       .
IF_SWN_PARAMETER               I GET_VALUE                     Read Individual Parameters with Conversion                  .
IF_SWN_PARAMETER               I GET_VALUES_RAW                Read Table of Parameters                                    .
IF_SWN_PARAMETER               I GET_VALUE_RAW                 Read Individual Parameters Without Conversion               .
IF_SWN_SCENARIO                I GET_DEF_CATEGORY              Read Corresponding Default Category                         .
IF_SWN_SCENARIO                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Description (Language-Dependent)                            .
IF_SWN_SCENARIO                I GET_FILTER                    Provide Filter Object                                       .
IF_SWN_SCENARIO                I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time of Last Notification Generation                        .
IF_SWN_SCENARIO                I RETRIEVE_NOTIFICATIONS        Generate Notifications from Application Objects             .
IF_SWN_SUBSCRIPTION            I FILTER_NOTIFICATIONS          Determine Notifications for Receiver Group                  .
IF_SWN_USER                    I GET_COMM_ADDR                 Determine Address for Communication Type                    .
IF_SWN_USER                    I GET_HASH_CODE                 Determine Hash Code from Receiver ID                        .
IF_SWN_USER                    I GET_LANGUAGE                  Determine User Language                                     .
IF_SWN_USER                    I GET_SALUTATION                Form of Address (for Example, for Newsletter) in User Lang. .
IF_SWN_USER                    I LOAD_INSTANCE                 Instantiate Object                                          .
IF_SXFT_CALCULATE              I SET_TYPE                      Obsolete                                                    .
IF_SXFT_CONTENTAREA            I SET_BORDER                    Obsolete                                                    .
IF_SXFT_CONTENTAREA            I SET_CAPTION                   Obsolete                                                    .
IF_SXFT_CONTENT_INTEGER        I SET_CONTENT                   Sets Integer Value                                          .
IF_SXFT_ITEMS                  I SET_LOCK                      Locks/Unlocks                                               .
IF_SXFT_ITEMS                  I SET_PRESENCE                  Sets Visibility                                             .
IF_SXFT_ITEMS                  I SET_SAVE                      Specifies whether display only or can be copied to field    .
IF_SXFT_PAGESET                I SET_RELATION                  Obsolete                                                    .
IF_SXFT_UI                     I SET_UI_ELEMENT                Sets UI Element                                             .
IF_SXMB_AGGREGATION            I AGGREGATE_DATA                Aggregate Raw Data and Write Aggregated Data Records        .
IF_SXMB_AGGREGATION            I SET_AGGR_ATTRIBUTES           Set Aggregation Attributes for Profile                      .
IF_SXMB_AGGREGATION            I SET_AGGR_VALUES               Set Aggregation Values for Profile                          .
IF_SXMB_AGGREGATION            I SET_AGGR_VIEWS                Set Views for Profile                                       .
IF_SXML_ENCODER                I DECODE                        Decode Part                                                 .
IF_SXML_ENCODER                I ENCODE                        Encode Part                                                 .
IF_SXML_ENCODER_CONTEXT        I FIND_ENCODER_BY_URI           Find a Registered Encoder                                   .
IF_SXML_ENCODER_CONTEXT        I GET_XML_STREAM                Get the Serializer                                          .
IF_SXML_ENCODER_CONTEXT        I REGISTER_ENCODER              Register an Encoder for Later Use                           .
IF_SXML_FRAGMENT               I ADD_NAMESPACE_WRAPPER         Add ROOT Element with All Predefined Namespaces to Fragment .
IF_SXML_NAMED                  I SET_PREFIX                    Sets the Preferred XMLNS Prefix                             .
IF_SXML_NSURI_HELPER           I GET_NSBINDINGS                Determines all valid namespace declarations                 .
IF_SXML_NSURI_HELPER           I GET_NSURI_BY_PREFIX           Determines namespace URI for namespace prefix               .
IF_SXML_NSURI_HELPER           I GET_PREFIX_BY_NSURI           Determines namespace prefix for namespace URI               .
IF_SXML_PART                   I GET_NS_BY_PREFIX              Gets Namespace for Prefix (Possibly Empty String)           .
IF_SXML_PART                   I GET_PREFIX_BY_NS              Gets Predefined Prefix (Possibly Empty String)              .
IF_SXML_READER                 I CURRENT_NODE                  Reset to Current Node, Iterator (Not Attribute)             .
IF_SXML_READER                 I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE           Read Value of a Specific Attribute                          .
IF_SXML_READER                 I NEXT_ATTRIBUTE                Read Next Attribute of the Current Elements (Iterator)      .
IF_SXML_READER                 I NEXT_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE          Value of the Current Attribute (after NEXT_ATTRIBUTE)       .
IF_SXML_READER                 I NEXT_NODE                     Read Next Node (Iterator)                                   .
IF_SXML_READER                 I PUSH_BACK                     Reset Node Last Read                                        .
IF_SXML_READER                 I READ_CURRENT_NODE             Reset to Current Node, Object (not attribute)               .
IF_SXML_READER                 I READ_NEXT_NODE                Read Next Node (Object)                                     .
IF_SXML_READER                 I SKIP_NODE                     Read Over Next Node                                         .
IF_SXML_VALUE                  I GET_VALUE                     Read Value                                                  .
IF_SXML_VALUE                  I GET_VALUE_RAW                 Read Value as Raw String                                    .
IF_SXML_VALUE                  I SET_VALUE                     Set value                                                   .
IF_SXML_VALUE                  I SET_VALUE_RAW                 Set Value as Raw String                                     .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I CLOSE_ELEMENT                 Close Element                                               .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I NEW_CLOSE_ELEMENT             Factory to Create an Element                                .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I NEW_OPEN_ELEMENT              Factory to Create an Element                                .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I NEW_VALUE                     Factory to Create a Value                                   .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I OPEN_ELEMENT                  Open Element                                                .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_ATTRIBUTE               Write Attribute                                             .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_ATTRIBUTE_RAW           Write Attribute (Type RAW)                                  .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_NAMESPACE_DECLARATION   Write Namespace Declaration                                 .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_NODE                    Write Node (Object)                                         .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_VALUE                   Write Value                                                 .
IF_SXML_WRITER                 I WRITE_VALUE_RAW               Write Value (Type RAW)                                      .
IF_SYSTEM_DME                  I GET_CLASS_AGENT               Gets Class Agent                                            .
IF_SYSTEM_DME                  I GET_SERVICE_AGENT             Gets Service Instance                                       .
IF_TAAN_RESULT                 I DELETE_FROM_DB                Delete Analysis Result from Database                        .
IF_TAAN_RESULT                 I GET_AS_NAME_VALUE_PAIRS       Show Analysis Result as Field Name-Field Value Pair         .
IF_TAAN_RESULT                 I GET_INTO_TABLE                Write Analysis Results to Indicated Tables                  .
IF_TAAN_RESULT                 I GET_TABLE_REFERENCE           Deliver Reference to Correctly Typized Result               .
IF_TABLECONTROL                I GET_VALUE_LINE                Provides Row for Table Control Output                       .
IF_TABLECONTROL                I PBO_GET_TC                    Provides Table Control Structure in PBO                     .
IF_TABLECONTROL                I PBO_INIT_SCREEN               Initialize Screen Fields                                    .
IF_TABLECONTROL                I SET_VALUE_LINE                Sets Values for a Table Control Row                         .
IF_TABLECONTROL                I USER_COMMAND                  USER_COMMAND Processing                                     .
IF_TABLE_BUFFER_APPL           I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete Class Instance - Release Buffer                      .
IF_TABLE_BUFFER_APPL           I GET_INSTANCE                  Provide Class Instance                                      .
IF_TABLE_MANAGER_MM            I LOOKUP                        Determine Table Object                                      .
IF_TABLE_NAVIGATOR_DME         I GET_ASSOCIATED_EDITOR         Gets Editor Dialog for Specified Destination                .
IF_TABLE_NAVIGATOR_DME         I NAVIGATE                      Performs Navigation Operations for Specified Row            .
IF_TASK_FAMILY_IAM             I EVENT_0                       IAM-Event: Normal                                           .
IF_TASK_FAMILY_IAM             I SELECT_TASKS                  Determines the Tasks of the Task Family from the Context    .
IF_TASK_IAM                    I EVENT_0                       Task No Longer Necessary, as Anomoly Has Disappeared        .
IF_TASK_IAM                    I EVENT_1                       Create Task                                                 .
IF_TASK_IAM                    I EVENT_S                       Select Task                                                 .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I AFTER_EVENT_0                 IAM Event: Normal - Event-Specific Postprocessing           .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I AFTER_EVENT_1                 IAM-Event: Anomalous - Event-Specific Postprocessing        .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I AFTER_EVENT_S                 IAM-Event: Selected - Event-Specific Postprocessing         .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I DESELECT_TASKS                Deselects All Tasks                                         .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I EVENT_0                       IAM-Event: Normal                                           .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I EVENT_1                       IAM-Event: Anomalous                                        .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I EVENT_S                       IAM-Event: Selected                                         .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I GET_TASKS                     Gets List of Current Tasks from the Application             .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I PUT_TASKS                     Returns List of Current Tasks to the Application            .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I RETURN_TASK                   Returns Task                                                .
IF_TASK_MANAGER_IAM            I SELECT_TASK                   Selects Concrete Task                                       .
IF_TCL_BIDIRECTIONAL_ITERATOR  I PREVIOUS_ENTRY                Previous Entry                                              .
IF_TCL_BIDIRECTIONAL_ITERATOR  I SET_NEXT_ENTRY                Determines the Next Entry                                   .
IF_TCL_GRAPH                   I ADD_EDGE                      Add Edge                                                    .
IF_TCL_GRAPH                   I ADD_VERTEX                    Insert Group                                                .
IF_TCL_GRAPH                   I FIND_VERTEX                   Find Node Using its Name                                    .
IF_TCL_GRAPH                   I IMPORT_VERTEX                 Import Node                                                 .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I FIRST_PAGE                    First Page                                                  .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I GET_CURRENT_PAGE              Find Current Page                                           .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I GET_LAST_PAGE                 Find Number of Pages                                        .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I GET_PAGE_SIZE                 Find Number of Lines per Page                               .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I GOTO_PAGE                     Goto Specified Page                                         .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I IS_FIRST_PAGE                 Check on First Page                                         .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I IS_LAST_PAGE                  Check on Last Page                                          .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I LAST_PAGE                     Last Page                                                   .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I NEXT_PAGE                     Next Page                                                   .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I PREVIOUS_PAGE                 Previous Page                                               .
IF_TCL_PAGE_ITERATOR           I SET_PAGE_SIZE                 Set Number of Lines per Page                                .
IF_TC_COMPOSITE_TRIGGER        I ATTACH_LEFT_OPERAND           Attach one of the two triggers                              .
IF_TC_COMPOSITE_TRIGGER        I ATTACH_RIGHT_OPERAND          Attach one of the two triggers                              .
IF_TC_COMPOSITE_TRIGGER        I GET_LEFT_OPERAND              Get one of the two triggers                                 .
IF_TC_COMPOSITE_TRIGGER        I GET_RIGHT_OPERAND             Get one of the two triggers                                 .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I ADD_EXPECTED_ARG              Set one of the expected arguments                           .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I ATTACH_EVT_TMPL               Attach event template with trigger                          .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I GET_EVT_TMPL                  Extract event template                                      .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I GET_EXPECTED_ARG              Read one of the expected arguments                          .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I GET_EXPECTED_ARGS             Read all of the expected arguments                          .
IF_TC_NEW_EVT_TRIGGER          I SET_EXPECTED_ARGS             Set some of the expected arguments                          .
IF_TC_PERIODTRIGGER_TOOLKIT    I MAKE_ONWORKDAYS_TRIGGER_TMPL  make effective trigger template for onWorkday trigger       .
IF_TC_TRIGGER_CHECK            I CHECK_VALIDATION              validate the triggers                                       .
IF_TC_TRIGGER_CHECK            I SET_COMPLETED                 check whether the definition of trigger is complete         .
IF_TECHNICALLY_MAPPABLE_S2L    I GET_CONTENT_TYPE              Reads Contents Type                                         .
IF_TECHNICALLY_MAPPABLE_S2L    I GET_TECHNICALLY_TYPE          Reads Technical Type                                        .
IF_TECHNICALLY_MAPPABLE_S2L    I SET_AREA                      Area is Set to the View                                     .
IF_TEMPLATE_REFERENCE_CK       I GET_COST_ESTIMATE_DATA        Data for Template Determination or Template with Environment.
IF_TEMPLATE_REFERENCE_CK       I GET_TEMPLATE_DATA             Data for Call up of ABC Template (Callback from Template)   .
IF_TEST_UK                     I DISPLAY                       Display                                                     .
IF_TEST_UK                     I EDIT                          Change                                                      .
IF_TEST_UK                     I GET_RANDOM                    Generate Random Number                                      .
IF_TEXT_IDENTIFIER             I IDENTIFY_TEXT                 Identify Text                                               .
IF_TEXT_IDENTIFIER             I READ_TEXT                     Get Text                                                    .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I FREE                          Expands the Implementation References                       .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I GET_CHANGES                   Returns the Changes                                         .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I GET_OUTTAB                    Returns the Table                                           .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I INIT                          Initializes the Implementation                              .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I SET_BASE                      Sets a Reference of CL_TFWB_BASE                            .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I SET_FIELDCATALOG              Sets the Field Catalog                                      .
IF_TFW_POPUP_ALV               I SET_OUTTAB                    Sets the Table for Display                                  .
IF_TIDX_PRICE_INDEX            I GETINDEXFACTOR4DISTFLOWTYPE   Get the Index Factor for a Distribution Flow Type           .
IF_TIDX_PRICE_INDEX            I GETINDEXNAME                  Get the Name of the Index                                   .
IF_TIDX_PRICE_INDEX            I GETINDEXTEXT                  Get the Index Text                                          .
IF_TIDX_PRICE_INDEX            I GETINDEXVALUEFORFLOW          Get the Index Value for a Specific Flow                     .
IF_TIDX_PRICE_INDEX            I ISFLOWINDEXRELEVANT           Returns 'X' or ' ' if the Flow is Index Relevant or Not     .
IF_TIMECALENDAR                I CALCDIFF_DAYS                 Calculate difference in days                                .
IF_TIMECALENDAR                I CALCDIFF_SECONDS              Calculate difference in seconds                             .
IF_TIMECALENDAR                I GET_INFO                      Returns an information text                                 .
IF_TIMECALENDAR                I MOVE_DAYS                     Add days to a start date                                    .
IF_TIMECALENDAR                I MOVE_SECONDS                  Add X seconds to a time (timestamp)                         .
IF_TIMECALENDAR_TIME           I ADD_SECONDS                   Add X seconds to a time (timestamp)                         .
IF_TIMECALENDAR_TIME           I GET_NEXT_VALID_TIME           Search for next valid time stamp                            .
IF_TIMECALENDAR_TIME           I GET_PREV_VALID_TIME           Search for last previously valid time stamp                 .
IF_TIMECALENDAR_TIME           I GET_TIMESLICE_TIME            Time slot to which a time stamp belongs (second calendar)   .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_CTPROFILE                 Returns as profile                                          .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_DURASET                   Supplies generic_set interface for event set                .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_DURA_CALLBACK             Supplies call back interface for events                     .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_EVENTSET                  Supplies generic_set interface for event set                .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_EVENT_CALLBACK            Supplies call back interface for events                     .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_TIMEOBJECTSET             Supplies generic_set interface for event set                .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I GET_TIMEOBJECT_CALLBACK       Supplies call back interface for events                     .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_CTPROFILE                 Sets the profile                                            .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_DURASET                   Set event set                                               .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_DURA_CALLBACK             Sets call back interface                                    .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_EVENTSET                  Set event set                                               .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_EVENT_CALLBACK            Sets call back interface                                    .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_TIMEOBJECTSET             Set event set                                               .
IF_TIMECONTEXT                 I SET_TIMEOBJECT_CALLBACK       Sets call back interface                                    .
IF_TIMECTPROFILE               I GET_PROFILENAME               Read Profile Name                                           .
IF_TIMEDURA_CALLBACK           I GET_DURA_BYID                 Gets a duration via ID                                      .
IF_TIMEDURA_CALLBACK           I GET_DURA_BYNAME               Gets a duration via the symbolic name                       .
IF_TIMEDURA_CTPROFILE          I CONTAINS_NAME                 Checks whether a symbolic name is allowed in the context    .
IF_TIMEDURA_CTPROFILE          I GET_CTPROFILENAME             Supplies the name of the context                            .
IF_TIMEDURA_CTPROFILE          I GET_INFO                      Supplies all information for a symbolic name                .
IF_TIMEDURA_CTPROFILE          I GET_NAMES                     Supplies all symbolic names of the context                  .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CALLBACK          I GET_EVENT_BYID                Gets an event via its ID                                    .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CALLBACK          I GET_EVENT_BYNAME              Gets an event via its symbolic name                         .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CTPROFILE         I CONTAINS_NAME                 Checks whether a symbolic name is allowed in the context    .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CTPROFILE         I GET_CTPROFILENAME             Supplies the context name                                   .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CTPROFILE         I GET_INFO                      Supplies all information for a symbolic name                .
IF_TIMEEVENT_CTPROFILE         I GET_NAMES                     Supplies list of symbolic names                             .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I FORMAT_TIMEEVENT              Formatted Output of a cl_timeevent Object                   .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I FORMAT_TIMEEVENT_N            Formatted Output of a cl_timeevent Object                   .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I FORMAT_TIMESTAMP              Formatted Output of Time Stamp and Time Zone                .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I FORMAT_TIMETIME               Formatted Output of a cl_timetime Object                    .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I GET_MESSAGES                  Supplies Instance to cl_timemessage                         .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I PARSE_TIMEEVENT               Writes Value to a cl_timeevent Object                       .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I PARSE_TIMEEVENT_N             Writes Value to a cl_timeevent Object                       .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I PARSE_TIMESTAMP               Creates a Time Stamp and a Time Zone                        .
IF_TIMEFORMAT                  I PARSE_TIMETIME                Writes Value to a cl_timetime Object                        .
IF_TIMEOBJECT                  I GET_NAME                      Determine Symbolic Name                                     .
IF_TIMEOBJECT                  I GET_TIMECALENDAR              Determine Calendar Information                              .
IF_TIMEOBJECT                  I GET_TIMEZONE                  Determine Time Zone                                         .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CALLBACK         I GET_TIMEOBJECT_BYID           Gets a Time Object Via Its ID                               .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CALLBACK         I GET_TIMEOBJECT_BYNAME         Gets a Time Object Via Its Name                             .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CTPROFILE        I CONTAINS_NAME                 Checks whether a name is allowed in the context             .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CTPROFILE        I GET_CTPROFILENAME             Supplies the name of a context profile                      .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CTPROFILE        I GET_INFO                      Supplies all information for a symbolic name in the context .
IF_TIMEOBJECT_CTPROFILE        I GET_NAMES                     Supplies all the symbolic names in the context              .
IF_TIMERULE_CTPROFILE          I CONTAINS_NAME                 Checks whether a symbolic name is allowed in the context    .
IF_TIMERULE_CTPROFILE          I GET_CTPROFILENAME             Supplies the context name                                   .
IF_TIMERULE_CTPROFILE          I GET_INFO                      Supplies all information for a symbolic name                .
IF_TIMERULE_CTPROFILE          I GET_NAMES                     Supplies list of symbolic names                             .
IF_TIMESET_IDFILTER            I CONTAINS_ID                   Does an ID exist in the filter?                             .
IF_TIMESET_ITEM                I CLONE                         Create a Copy                                               .
IF_TIMESET_ITEM                I CREATE_FACTORY                Create an Instance (Factory Method)                         .
IF_TIMESET_ITEM                I GET_ID                        Returns GUID                                                .
IF_TIMESET_ITEM                I GET_NAME                      Returns Name                                                .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I FIRST                         Goto first entry                                            .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I GET_CURRENT                   Read current element                                        .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I IS_DONE                       Supplies xflag whether iterator is already at the end       .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I LAST                          Goto last entry                                             .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I NEXT                          Goto next entry                                             .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I PREVIOUS                      Goto previous entry                                         .
IF_TIMESET_ITERATOR            I REMOVE                        Removes current element                                     .
IF_TIMESET_NAMEFILTER          I CONTAINS_NAME                 Does the filter contain a name                              .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I ADD_DURA_TO_DURA              Add Duration to Duration                                    .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I CONVERT_FROM_BASEUNIT         Converts duration of base unit into this unit               .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I CONVERT_TO_BASEUNIT           Converts a duration into its base unit                      .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I DIFF_DURA                     Difference between time durations in this unit              .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I DIFF_TIME                     Difference between two times in this unit                   .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I GET_BASEUNIT                  Returns the base unit (as name)                             .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I GET_TIMESLICE                 Calculates the time slot for a time                         .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I GET_UNIT_NUMBER               Number of time unit in which time falls                     .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I MOVE                          Go x units forwards or backwards (relative)                 .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I MOVE_TO                       Go to unit with number X                                    .
IF_TIMEUNIT_CALC               I ROUND                         Round to this unit from a time                              .
IF_TIME_CONTEXT_PPF            I GET_TIME_CONTEXT              Read Time Context                                           .
IF_TIME_CONVERTER_S2L          I TO_DATE_AND_TIME              Conversion to Date and Time                                 .
IF_TIME_CONVERTER_S2L          I TO_TIMESTAMP                  Conversion to Time Stamp                                    .
IF_TIME_CONVERTER_S2L          I USED_TZONE                    Time Zone to Be Used                                        .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I ACTIVATE_WP                   Activate Watchpoint                                         .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I DEL_WP                        Delete a Watchpoint                                         .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I FIELD_DIFF                    Compare Contenf of Fields                                   .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I GET_COMMON_PART_NAME          Define COMMON PART                                          .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I GET_EXCOBJ_SRCINFO            Trigger Location of an Exception Object                     .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I GET_LOADED_PROGRAMS           Loaded programs                                             .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I GET_SYSTEM_AREA               System Area Display                                         .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I GET_WPS                       Get All Active Watchpoints                                  .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I ITAB_SEARCH                   Search in Internal Table                                    .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I PATTERN_SEARCH_SEQUENCE       Search in Byte Strings and Character Strings                .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I SET_WP                        Set Watchpoint                                              .
IF_TPDA_CONTROL                I SYSTEM_AREA_SEARCH            Search in the System Area Display                           .
IF_TPDA_SEARCH                 I SEARCH                        Method for Functionality Searches                           .
IF_TPDA_SEARCH_RESULT_TABULAR  I GET_LINE                      Return the Object Content                                   .
IF_TPDA_SEARCH_RESULT_TABULAR  I GET_LINESTRUC                 ALV Field Catalog Structure                                 .
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I CREATE                        Factory: Create an Instance of the Tool                     .
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I DELETE                        Delete a Tool Instance (Call Before Releasing the Instance) .
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I GET_VIEW                      Returns Display Component of Instance (for Example, Subscr.).
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I INIT                          Initialization of a Tool Instance                           .
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I IS_AVAILABLE                  Factory: Can a new tool instance be created?                .
IF_TPDA_TOOL                   I RELEASE                       Release a Tool Instance to the Factory                      .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I CLEAR_TRACE                   Deletes Trace Table                                         .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I CREATE_TRACE_OBJECT           Delivers Trace Object                                       .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_BREAK_AT_PREPARE          Delivers Boolean Value of Prepare                           .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_BREAK_AT_PROCESS          Delivers Boolean Value of Process                           .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_BREAK_EXPRESSION          Delivers Boolean Value of Expression                        .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_TRACE                     Returns Trace Table                                         .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_TRACE_DISP_EVENT_ALL      Delivers Trace Disp Event All                               .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I GET_TRACE_DISP_EVT            Delivers trace disp event                                   .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I REMOVE_TRACE                  Removes Current Trace Entry                                 .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I RESET_BREAK_INFO              Deletes Break Point                                         .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I SAVE_TRACE                    Saves Trace to DB                                           .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I SET_BREAK_INFO                Sets Break Point                                            .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I SET_SHOW_TRACE_AT_END         Means that Trace Is Displayed at End of Transaction         .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I SET_SHOW_TRACE_AT_EVENT       Triggers Display of Trace at End of Each Event              .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I SHOW_TRACE                    Displays Trace Table                                        .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I TRACE_OFF                     Switches Off Trace                                          .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I TRACE_ON                      Switches On Trace                                           .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I WRITE_TRACE_END               Adds New Trace Entry (End of Block)                         .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I WRITE_TRACE_MESSAGE           Add Message to a Trace Entry                                .
IF_TRACE_BRF                   I WRITE_TRACE_START             Adds New Trace Entry (Start of Block)                       .
IF_TRANSACTION_PPF             I RESET_GUIDS                   Reject Unique IDs                                           .
IF_TRANSACTION_PPF             I SAVE_GUIDS                    Transfer Unique IDs to Be Saved                             .
IF_TRANSACTION_PPF             I SET_GUID                      Set Current Unique ID                                       .
IF_TRANSFER_TO_BEPP            I EXECUTE                       Execute                                                     .
IF_TREE_NAVIGATOR_DME          I EXECUTE                       Performs a Command on a Node                                .
IF_TREE_NAVIGATOR_DME          I GET_ASSOCIATED_EDITOR         Gets the Editor Dialog for the Specified Node               .
IF_TREE_NAVIGATOR_DME          I NAVIGATE                      Performs Navigation Operation for Specified Node            .
IF_TRFC_UNIT_INBOUND           I CREATE_UNIT_BY_PATTERN        Generates New Unit with Same Properties                     .
IF_TRFC_UNIT_OUTBOUND          I CREATE_UNIT_BY_PATTERN        Generates New Unit with Same Properties                     .
IF_TRX_VTTX                    I TRX_GET_VTTX                  Shipment data                                               .
IF_TTE_CLIENT_COPY             I COPY_TO_CLIENT                Copies records from client dependent tables of src to target.
IF_TTE_CLIENT_COPY             I DELETE_FROM_CLIENT            Deletes the records from client dependent tables of client  .
IF_TTE_CLIENT_COPY             I GET_DEFAULT_INPUT             Obtains the default values for the input (source & target)  .
IF_TTE_CLIENT_COPY             I VALIDATE_INPUT                Method that validates the input(s) specified                .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I CALCULATE_TAXES               TTE Calculate Taxes (TTE Document is Table format )         .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I CALCULATE_TAXES_XML           Calculate_Taxes (TTE Document is in XML format )            .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_ANALYSIS                  Get Pricing Analysis Document                               .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_DOCUMENT_TABLE            Get TTE Document (Table format )                            .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_DOCUMENT_XML              Get TTE Document (XML format )                              .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_F4_HELP1                  Get F4 Help1 for a Entity                                   .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_F4_HELP2                  Get F4 Help2 for a Entity  (Country dep.)                   .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_KERNEL_PARAMETERS         Get TTE Kernel parameters                                   .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I GET_VERSION                   Get TTE Version Info                                        .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I REFRESH_CUSTOMIZING           Refresh TTE customizing buffer                              .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I REMOVEDOCUMENTFROMSESSION     Remove TteDocument from SessionData                         .
IF_TTE_COMMUNICATION           I SEND_DOC_TO_TTE               Send Input Document to TTE( Command = 1)                    .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_COPY            I COPY_COUNTRY_CUSTOMIZING      Method that copies only the country specific customizing    .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_COPY            I COPY_DECISION_TREE            Method that copies, checks and releases the decision tree   .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_COPY            I COPY_TAX_RATES                Method that copies the tax rates (from condition records)   .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_COPY            I VALIDATE_INPUT                Method that validates the input provided                    .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_DELETE          I DELETE_COUNTRY_CUSTOMIZING    Method that deletes the country specific customizing        .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_DELETE          I DELETE_DECISION_TREE          Method that deletes the decision trees of the country       .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_DELETE          I DELETE_TAX_RATES              Method that deletes the tax rates from condition records    .
IF_TTE_COUNTRY_DELETE          I VALIDATE_INPUT                Method that validates the input provided                    .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I GET_INPUT_DOCUMENT            Get TTE Input Document                                      .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I GET_INPUT_DOCUMENT_TO_XML     Get TTE Input Document as XML Stream                        .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I GET_OUTPUT_DOCUMENT           Get TTE Output Document                                     .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I GET_OUTPUT_DOCUMENT_TO_XML    Get TTE Output Document as XML Stream                       .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I GET_TTEDOCUMENTID             Get TTE Document ID                                         .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_INPUT_DOCUMENT_FROM_XML   Set  input document from XML                                .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_COUNTRIES               Set input document : CurrencyConversions                    .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_CURRCONV                Set input document : CurrencyConversions                    .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_HEADER                  Set input document : Header                                 .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_ITEMS                   Set input document : Items                                  .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_PARTNERS                Set input document : Partners                               .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_PRICEL                  Set input document : PricingElements                        .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_PRODUCTS                Set input document : Products                               .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_TAXCODEVALUE            Set input document : CurrencyConversions                    .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_I_TAXEVENTS               Set input document : TaxEvents                              .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_OUTPUT_DOCUMENT           Set TTE Output Document                                     .
IF_TTE_DOCUMENT                I SET_OUTPUT_DOCUMENT_FROM_XML  Set  input document from XML                                .
IF_TTE_TRANSPORT_CUST          I LOAD_TRANSPORT_STRUC          Loads the structures required for transport                 .
IF_TTE_TRANSPORT_CUST          I TRANSPORT_CUSTOMIZING         Method to transport customizing                             .
IF_TTE_WT_ACCUMVALU            I ACCUMULATE                    Accumulated the values                                      .
IF_TTE_WT_ACCUMVALU            I READ                          Read accumulated vaues from DB                              .
IF_TTE_WT_ACCUMVALU            I SAVE                          Save accumulated values to the DB                           .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I ADD_EDGE                      Add Edge to Model                                           .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I ADD_EDGE_VALUE                add value for edge                                          .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I ADD_ROOT_NODE                 Add Root Node to Model                                      .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I ADD_TREE                      Add Tree to Model                                           .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I CHANGE_EDGE                   Change Object Reference of Edge                             .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I CHANGE_EDGE_VALUE             Change Value and Object Reference of Edge Value             .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I DISPLAY_EDGE_VALUES           Display Edge Values for Node                                .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_EDGES_FOR_NODE            View, Get All Edges where Node Is Source or Target          .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_EDGE_FOR_NODES            Get edge with specified nodes                               .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_EDGE_OBJECT               Get Object Reference                                        .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_HIERARCHY_COLUMN          View, Get ID of Hierarchy Column                            .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_LEFT_TREE_ID              Get Tree to the Left                                        .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_NODES_FOR_EDGE            View, Get Source and Target Node of an Edge                 .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_POSSIBLE_RECEIVERS        View, get possible receivers of a node                      .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_POSSIBLE_SENDERS          View, get possible senders of a node                        .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_RIGHT_TREE_ID             Get Tree to the Right                                       .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_ROOT_NODES                View, Get All Root Nodes                                    .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_TREES                     View, Get Tree IDs in order                                 .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_TREE_FOR_COLUMN           View, Get Tree ID for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I GET_TREE_FOR_NODE             View, Get Tree ID for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I IS_EDGE_COLUMN                view, this column holds edge values                         .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I QUERY                         Query this Interface                                        .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I RAISE_ASSIGNMENT_EVENT        manually raise event                                        .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I REMOVE_EDGE                   Remove Edge from Model                                      .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I REMOVE_EDGE_VALUE             Remove edge_value from Model                                .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMENT_MODEL        I SET_EDGE_COLUMN               this column displays edge values                            .
IF_UAC_ASSIGNMNT_STYLE_MANAGER I QUERY                         Query this Interface                                        .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_ANY                       Attribute service: get attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_DREF                      Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_ITEMS_WITH_ANY            Attribute service: get all items where attribute is set     .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_ITEMS_WITH_ATTRIBUTE      Attribute service: get all items where attribute is set     .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_ITEMS_WITH_DREF           Attribute service: get all items where attribute is set     .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_ITEMS_WITH_OREF           Attribute service: get all items where attribute is set     .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I GET_OREF                      Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I IS_SET                        Attribute service: TRUE if attribute is set on item         .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I REMOVE                        Attribute service: remove attribute for item                .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE              Attribute service: remove attribute from service            .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I REMOVE_ITEM                   Attribute service: remove item (include dependent items)    .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I SET_ANY                       Attribute service: set attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I SET_DREF                      Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE               I SET_OREF                      Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_FLAG          I ADD_FLAG                      Add flag for item                                           .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_FLAG          I CHECK_FLAG                    Check if item has flag                                      .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_FLAG          I DELETE_FLAG                   Delete flag of item                                         .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_FLAG          I GET_ITEMS                     Get list of items with specific flag                        .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_ID            I GET                           Get Attribute ID for Item                                   .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_ID            I GET_ITEMS                     Get List of Items for Attribute ID                          .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_ID            I REMOVE                        Remove Attribute ID for Item                                .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_ID            I SET                           Set Attribute ID for Item                                   .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_TREE_ID       I GET                           Get Tree Relation for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_TREE_ID       I GET_ITEMS                     Get List of Items for Tree                                  .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_TREE_ID       I REMOVE                        Remove Tree Relation for Item                               .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_TREE_ID       I SET                           Set Tree Relation for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET                           Get Item Value                                              .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I GET_TAB                       Get item value tab                                          .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I REMOVE                        Remove Item Value                                           .
IF_UAC_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE         I SET                           Set Item Value                                              .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I ADD_EDGE_STYLE                Add Style Properties for Edges                              .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I CHANGE_EDGE_STYLE             Change Style Properties for Edges                           .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_EDGE_STYLES               View: Get Edge Style Data                                   .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_EDGE_STYLE_IDS            View: Get Style ID for Edges                                .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_DEFAULT_EDGE_STYLE        Set Default Style Properties of Edges                       .
IF_UAC_EDGE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_EDGE_STYLE                Set style properties for edges                              .
IF_UAC_FILTER                  I IS_FILTERED                   Item is filtered                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_ALV_TREE            I SET_BACKEND_FCAT              Performance: do not get fcat from frontend, use mt_fcat     .
IF_UAC_GUI_ALV_TREE            I SET_FRONTEND_UPDATE           Performance: enable/disable frontend update                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I GET_ALL_NODES_ALLOWED         GET_ALL_NODES_ALLOWED                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I GET_ASSIGNMENT_FLOW           GET_ASSIGNMENT_FLOW                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I GET_ASSIGNMENT_NODE           GET_ASSIGNMENT_NODE                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I GET_FOCUS_TREE                GET_FOCUS_TREE                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I HIDE_TREE                     HIDE_TREE                                                   .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I INDICATE_POSSIBLE_EDGES       INDICATE_POSSIBLE_EDGES                                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I IS_TREE_HIDDEN                IS_TREE_HIDDEN                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I SET_ALL_NODES_ALLOWED         SET_ALL_NODES_ALLOWED                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I SET_ASSIGNMENT_FLOW           SET_ASSIGNMENT_FLOW                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I SET_ASSIGNMENT_HEADER         SET_ASSIGNMENT_HEADER                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I SET_ASSIGNMENT_NODE           SET_ASSIGNMENT_NODE                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE                I SET_ASSIGNMENT_WIDTH          SET_ASSIGNMENT_WIDTH                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_HIDE_TREE              hide this tree                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_EDGE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_SET_ASSIGNMENT_FLOW    toggle on/off the assignment flow                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I ACTIVATE_DISPLAY_PROTOCOL     Output Log in Dialog                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I ACTIVATE_REPREP_INTERFACE     Enable Report/Report Interface                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I APPEND_ROWS                   Append Rows at End                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I CELL_DISPLAY                  Output Cell                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I CHANGE_DATA_FROM_INSIDE       for internal use only!                                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check Changes and Fire Event DATA_CHANGED                   .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I FCODE_BOUNCER                 Internal, Temporary, Do not Use!                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_ACTUAL_VIEW               Gets Current View                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_BACKEND_FIELDCATALOG      INTERNAL USE ONLY                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_CURRENT_CELL              Current Row                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_FILTERED_ENTRIES          Hash Table of Filtered Entries                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_FILTER_CRITERIA           Get Filter Criteria                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_FRONTEND_FIELDCATALOG     Get Current Field Catalog from Frontend                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_FRONTEND_LAYOUT           Get Current Layout from Frontend                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_FRONTEND_PRINT            Get Current Print from Frontend                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SCROLL_INFO_VIA_ID        Use ID to Get Scroll Information                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SELECTED_CELLS            Get Selected Cells                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SELECTED_CELLS_ID         Get Selected Cell IDs                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Get Selected Columns                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Get Selected Rows                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SORT_CRITERIA             Get Sort Criteria                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_SUBTOTALS                 Get Subtotals Table                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I GET_VARIANT                   Get Layout                                                  .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I IS_READY_FOR_INPUT            Check for Current Editibility                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I IS_SHOWING                    TRUE when show( ) has been called                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I LIST_PROCESSING_EVENTS        Interface Method Classic ALV to ALV Control                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I OFFLINE                       Batch or Web Reporting                                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I PROCESS_UCOMM_ON_INVALID_INPUTUcomms To Be Processed Even in Case of Invalid Input        .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I RAISE_EVENT                   Raise 'USER_COMMAND'                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I REFRESH_TABLE_DISPLAY         Redisplay Table                                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I REGISTER_DELAYED_EVENT        Set Delayed Event (change_selection or moved_cell)          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I REGISTER_EDIT_EVENT           Register Edit Events                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I REGISTER_F4_FOR_FIELDS        Register F4 Handling for Fields                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SAVE_GRID_VARIANTS_SIMUL      Save Grid Variants with Current                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SAVE_VARIANT                  Save Layout                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SAVE_VARIANT_DARK             Save Variant in Background                                  .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SELECT_TEXT_IN_CURR_CELL      Select Text                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_3D_BORDER                 Sets 3D Frame                                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_AUTOREDRAW                Autoredraw                                                  .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_CURRENT_CELL_VIA_ID       Current Row                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_DELTA_CELLS               For Internal Use Only!!                                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_DROP_DOWN_TABLE           Set Dropdown Table                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_ERROR_LOG                 For Internal Use Only!!                                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_FILTER_CRITERIA           Set Filter Conditions                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_FRONTEND_FIELDCATALOG     Set Field Catalog                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_FRONTEND_LAYOUT           Set Frontend Layout                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_FRONTEND_PRINT            Set Frontend Print                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_FUNCTION_CODE             Internal Use Only!                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_GRAPHICS_CONTAINER        Pass Graphic Container                                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_GRIDTITLE                 Pass Grid Title                                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_HEADER_TRANSPORT          For Internal Use only!                                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_HTML_HEADER               Excel Header Set                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_LAYOUT_OF_DOUBLEGRID      Configures the Double Grid for the Layout (DV)              .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_READY_FOR_INPUT           Set/Reset Ready for Input Status                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SCROLL_INFO_VIA_ID        Use ID to Set Scroll Information                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SELECTED_CELLS            Set Cell Selections                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SELECTED_CELLS_ID         Set Cell Selections                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Set Column Selections                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SELECTED_ROWS             Set Selected Rows                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_SORT_CRITERIA             Set Sort Criteria                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Formatted Output Table is Sent to Control                   .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_TOOLBAR_INTERACTIVE       Set Toolbar Status                                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_USER_COMMAND              Set User Command                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_GRID                I SET_VARIANT                   Set Display Variant                                         .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I DISPLAY_GROUP_PANEL           switch grouping panel on/off                                .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I GET_GROUP_BY_INFORMATION      get column order and column sorting from grouping panel     .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I IS_GROUPING_ACTIVE            is the tree currently in grouping mode?                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I IS_GROUPING_LOCKED            Is grouping currently locked?                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I IS_GROUP_PANEL_DISPLAYED      Is grouping panel currently displayed?                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I IS_GROUP_SHOWN_AS_TREE        Is 'show as tree' - grouping mode currently on?             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I SET_GROUP_BY_INFORMATION      set column order and sorting in grouping panel              .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I SET_GROUP_PANEL_TEXT          set default text (is displayed when grouping panel is empty).
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I SET_LOCKED_AT_GROUPING        set frontend or backend grouping mode                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP               I SHOW_GROUP_AS_TREE            set the 'tree' or the 'borg' visualization mode             .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP_CMD_FACTORY   I CREATE_ADD_TO_PANEL           add column to grouping panel                                .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP_CMD_FACTORY   I CREATE_DISPLAY_GROUP_PANEL    show/hide grouping panel                                    .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP_CMD_FACTORY   I CREATE_REMOVE_FROM_PANEL      remove column from grouping panel                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_GROUP_CMD_FACTORY   I CREATE_SET_LOCKED_AT_GROUPING switch lock at grouping                                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I ADD_EVENT_HANDLER             ADD_EVENT_HANDLER                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I COLLAPSE_NODE                 COLLAPSE_NODE                                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I EDIT_VALUE                    CALL EDIT POPUP                                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I ENSURE_VISIBLE                ENSURE_VISIBLE                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I EXPAND_NODE                   EXPAND_NODE                                                 .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I FREE                          abstract: free me                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_COLUMN_ORDER              GET_COLUMN_ORDER                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_COLUMN_SORT_ORDER         GET_COLUMN_SORT_ORDER                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_COLUMN_WIDTH              GET_COLUMN_WIDTH                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_CONVERTER                 returns the int"-"ext value converter                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         GET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_GUI_CONTROL_OBJECT        must be redefined: GET_GUI_CONTROL_OBJECT                   .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_PARENT_CONTAINER          GET_PARENT_CONTAINER                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_SELECTED_CELL             GET_SELECTED_CELL returns the cell that is actually selected.
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_SELECTED_NODE             GET_SELECTED_NODE returns the node that is actually selected.
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_SELECTED_NODES            GET_SELECTED_NODES returns the nodes that are actually selec.
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_STYLE_MANAGER             GET_STYLE_MANAGER                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I GET_TREE_MODEL                GET_TREE_MODEL                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I HIDE_COLUMN                   HIDE_COLUMN hide (do not delete) column(s) at frontend      .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_COLUMN_HIDDEN              TRUE when column is hidden at frontend                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_EDITABLE                   TRUE when actual edit mode allows editing at frontend       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_NODE_1ST_EXPANDED          TRUE when the node is first expanded                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_NODE_EXPANDED              TRUE when the node is actually expanded at frontend         .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_NODE_VISIBLE               TRUE when the node is actually visible at frontend          .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_SHOWING                    TRUE when show( ) has been called                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I IS_SORTING_ALLOWED            TRUE when column sorting is actually allowed at frontend    .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I OPTIMIZE_COLUMN               OPTIMIZE_COLUMN adjust column width to optimum              .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I OPTIMIZE_TREE                 OPTIMIZE_TREE adjust all columns, then tree width to optimum.
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I REGISTER_EVENTS               must be redefined: REGISTER_EVENTS                          .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER          REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER                                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_COLUMN_ORDER              SET_COLUMN_ORDER                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_COLUMN_SORT_ORDER         SET_COLUMN_SORT_ORDER                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_COLUMN_WIDTH              SET_COLUMN_WIDTH                                            .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_CONVERTER                 not possible when converter has already been used           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         SET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER                                       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_EDITABLE                  set edit mode of control: False-"display, True-"edit        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_FCODE                     set and execute function code for view                      .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_FILTER                    Set filter                                                  .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_SELECTED_CELL             SET_SELECTED_CELL set the selected cell at frontend         .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_SELECTED_NODE             SET_SELECTED_NODE set the selected node at frontend         .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_SELECTED_NODES            SET_SELECTED_NODES set the selected nodes at frontend       .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_SORTING_ALLOWED           SET_SORTING_ALLOWED allows or denies sorting at frontend    .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_STYLE_MANAGER             SET_STYLE_MANAGER                                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_TREE_MODEL                SET_TREE_MODEL                                              .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SET_TREE_WIDTH                SET_TREE_WIDTH set the width of the frontend control        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I SHOW                          SHOW must be called to display the tree                     .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE                I UNSELECT_ALL                  UNSELECT_ALL                                                .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_CMD_COLLAPSE_NODE      Generates Node Collapse Command                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_CMD_EXPAND_NODE        Generates Node Expand Command                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_CMD_OPTIMIZE_COLUMN    Generates Optimize Column Command                           .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_COLLAPSE_NODE          Generates Node Collapse Command                             .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_EXPAND_NODE            Generates Node Expand Command                               .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_HIDE_COLUMN            Generates Column_Hide/Unhide Command                        .
IF_UAC_GUI_TREE_CMD_FACTORY    I CREATE_OPTIMIZE_COLUMN        Generates Optimize Column Command                           .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I ADD                           Add ID to Mapping Service                                   .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I CHANGE                        Change External ID                                          .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I EXIST                         TRUE if ID Exists in Mapping Service                        .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I GET_EXT                       Get external ID from internal ID                            .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I GET_INT                       Get internal ID from external ID                            .
IF_UAC_MAP                     I REMOVE                        Remove ID from Mapping Service                              .
IF_UAC_MENU_ITEM_VISITOR       I VISIT_ITEM                    VISIT_ITEM                                                  .
IF_UAC_MENU_ITEM_VISITOR       I VISIT_MENU                    VISIT_MENU                                                  .
IF_UAC_MENU_ITEM_VISITOR       I VISIT_SEPARATOR               VISIT_SEPERATOR                                             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_COLUMN                    Add Data Column to Model                                    .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_EDGE                      Add Edge to Model                                           .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_EDGE_VALUE                add value for edge                                          .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_NODE                      Add Node to Model                                           .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_ROOT_NODE                 Add Root Node to Model                                      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ADD_TREE                      Add Tree and Hierarchy Column to Model, Must Be Called      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ANY             Attribute service: get attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_DREF            Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS           Attribute service: get items where attribute is set         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_ANY  Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_DREF Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_OREF Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_GET_OREF            Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_IS_SET              Attribute service: TRUE if attribute is set on item         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_REMOVE              Attribute service: remove attribute from attribute service  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_REMOVE_FOR_ITEM     Attribute service: remove attribute for item                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_SET_ANY             Attribute service: set attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_SET_DREF            Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I ATTRIBUTE_SET_OREF            Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I CHANGE_COLUMN                 Change Column Value                                         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I CHANGE_EDGE_VALUE             Change Value and Object Reference of Edge Value             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I CHANGE_EXT_ID                 Mapping: Change External ID                                 .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Node Value                                           .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I DISPLAY_EDGE_VALUES           Display Edge Values for Node                                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I EXIST                         Returns True if Item is in Model                            .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_CELL_VALUE                View, Get Cell Value                                        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_CHILDREN_IN_ORDER         View, Get Child Nodes                                       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_COLUMNS                   View, get all columns of a tree                             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_COLUMN_VALUE              View, Get Text of Column Header                             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_EDGES_FOR_NODE            View, Get All Edges where Node Is Source or Target          .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_EDGE_FOR_NODES            Get edge with specified nodes                               .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_EXT_ID                    Mapping Service: Get External ID from Internal ID           .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_EXT_ID_TABLE              Mapping Service: Get External IDs from Internal IDs         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_HIERARCHY_COLUMN          View, Get ID of Hierarchy Column                            .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_INT_ID                    Mapping Service: Get Internal ID from External ID           .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_INT_ID_TABLE              Mapping Service: Get Internal IDs from External IDs         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_LEFT_TREE_ID              Get Tree to the Left                                        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_LINE                      View, get value & style for node and its cells              .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_MODEL_ID                  Get Model ID                                                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_NEXT_COLUMN_ID            View, Get Right Column                                      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_NEXT_SIBLING              Get Next Node on Same Hierarchy Level                       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_NODES_FOR_EDGE            View, Get Source and Target Node of an Edge                 .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_NODE_VALUE                View, Get Node Text for Hierarchy Column                    .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_PARENT                    View, Get Parent Node                                       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_POSSIBLE_RECEIVERS        View, get possible receivers of a node                      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_POSSIBLE_SENDERS          View, get possible senders of a node                        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_PREVIOUS_SIBLING          View, Get Previous Node on same Hierarchy Level             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_RIGHT_TREE_ID             Get Tree to the Right                                       .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_ROOT_NODES                View, Get All Root Nodes                                    .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_ROOT_PATH                 get node ids to the root node                               .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_SUBTREE                   Get All Nodes in a Subtree                                  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_TREES                     View, Get Tree IDs in order                                 .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_TREE_FOR_COLUMN           View, Get Tree ID for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I GET_TREE_FOR_NODE             View, Get Tree ID for Item                                  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I IS_EDGE_COLUMN                view, this column holds edge values                         .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I IS_HIERARCHY_COLUMN           View, True if Column Is a Hierarchy Column                  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I IS_LEAF                       view, true if node is a leaf (a leaf must not have children).
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I IS_ROOT_NODE                  True if node is a root node                                 .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I MOVE_NODE                     Move Subtree                                                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I QUERY                         Query this Interface                                        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I RAISE_EVENT                   manually raise event                                        .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REFRESH                       refresh values of nodes, columns and cells                  .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_ALL_NODES              remove all nodes from model                                 .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_CELL                   Remove Cell from Model                                      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_COLUMN                 Remove Column from Model                                    .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_EDGE                   Remove Edge from Model                                      .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_EDGE_VALUE             Remove edge_value from Model                                .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I REMOVE_NODE                   Remove Subtree from Model                                   .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I SET_CELL                      add/change cell                                             .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I SET_CELL_VALUE                view, set new cell value                                    .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I SET_EDGE_COLUMN               this column displays edge values                            .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I SET_NODE_VALUE                view, set new node text                                     .
IF_UAC_MODEL                   I SET_VALUE_PROVIDER            Set call back for 'get/set_item_value' methods              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I ADD_EVENT_HANDLER             over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I GET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I GET_STYLE_MANAGER             over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I GET_TREE_MODEL                over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I REGISTER_EVENTS               over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER          over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I SET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I SET_STYLE_MANAGER             over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I SET_TREE_MODEL                over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I SET_TREE_WIDTH                over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ASSIGNMENT_TREE  I UNSELECT_ALL                  over definition for cl_uac_gui_assignment_tree              .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ATREE_ABSTRACT   I ADD_EVENT_HANDLER             over definition for cl_uac_gui_atree_abstract               .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ATREE_ABSTRACT   I GET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         over definition for cl_uac_gui_atree_abstract               .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ATREE_ABSTRACT   I REGISTER_EVENTS               over definition for cl_uac_gui_atree_abstract               .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ATREE_ABSTRACT   I REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER          over definition for cl_uac_gui_atree_abstract               .
IF_UAC_OD_GUI_ATREE_ABSTRACT   I SET_CTXT_MENU_MANAGER         over definition for cl_uac_gui_atree_abstract               .
IF_UAC_TREE_HANDLER            I CHECK_CELL_VALUE              CHECK_CELL_VALUE                                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_HANDLER            I CHECK_NODE_VALUE              CHECK_NODE_VALUE                                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_HANDLER            I GET_DROPDOWN_MENU             GET_DROPDOWN_MENU                                           .
IF_UAC_TREE_HANDLER            I ON_CELL_DROPDOWN_SELECTED     ON_CELL_DROPDOWN_SELECTED                                   .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ADD_COLUMN                    Add Data Column to Model                                    .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ADD_NODE                      Add Node to Model                                           .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ADD_ROOT_NODE                 Add Root Node to Model                                      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ADD_TREE                      Add Tree and Hierarchy Column to Model, Must Be Called      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ANY             Attribute service: get attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_DREF            Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS           Attribute service: get items where attribute is set         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_ANY  Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_DREF Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_ITEMS_WITH_OREF Attribute service: get all items with attribute value       .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_GET_OREF            Attribute service: get attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_IS_SET              Attribute service: TRUE if attribute is set on item         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_REMOVE              Attribute service: remove attribute from attribute service  .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_REMOVE_FOR_ITEM     Attribute service: remove attribute for item                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_SET_ANY             Attribute service: set attribute of type ANY                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_SET_DREF            Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO DATA        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I ATTRIBUTE_SET_OREF            Attribute service: set attribute of type REF TO OBJECT      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I CHANGE_COLUMN                 Change Column Value                                         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I CHANGE_EXT_ID                 Mapping: Change External ID                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I CHANGE_NODE                   Change Node Value                                           .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I EXIST                         Returns True if Item is in Model                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_CELL_VALUE                View, Get Cell Value                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_CHILDREN_IN_ORDER         View, Get Child Nodes                                       .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_COLUMNS                   get columns in order                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_COLUMN_VALUE              View, Get Text of Column Header                             .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_EXT_ID                    Mapping Service: Get External ID from Internal ID           .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_EXT_ID_TABLE              Mapping Service: Get External IDs from Internal IDs         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_HIERARCHY_COLUMN          View, Get ID of Hierarchy Column                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_INT_ID                    Mapping Service: Get Internal ID from External ID           .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_INT_ID_TABLE              Mapping Service: Get Internal IDs from External IDs         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_ITEMS_VALUE               view, get value of items                                    .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_LINE                      View, get node and cell data                                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_MODEL_ID                  Get Model ID                                                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NEXT_COLUMN_ID            View, Get Right Column                                      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NEXT_SIBLING              Get Next Node on Same Hierarchy Level                       .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NODE                      get hierarchical data for node ( parent, sibling, level... ).
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NODE_LEVEL                get hierarchy level for node                                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NODE_OBJECT               Get Object Reference                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NODE_POSITION             get node position within hierarchy level                    .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_NODE_VALUE                get node text for hierarchy column                          .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_PARENT                    get parent node                                             .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_PREVIOUS_SIBLING          get previous node on same hierarchy level                   .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_ROOT_NODES                get all root nodes                                          .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_ROOT_PATH                 get node ids to the root node                               .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I GET_SUBTREE                   Get All Nodes in a Subtree                                  .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I IS_HIERARCHY_COLUMN           true if column is a hierarchy column                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I IS_LEAF                       true if node is a leaf (a leaf must not have children)      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I IS_ROOT_NODE                  True if node is a root node                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I MOVE_COLUMN                   Change Column Order                                         .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I MOVE_NODE                     Move Subtree                                                .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I QUERY                         Query this Interface                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I RAISE_EVENT                   manually raise event                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I REFRESH                       refresh values of nodes, columns and cells                  .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I REMOVE_ALL_NODES              remove all nodes from model                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I REMOVE_CELL                   Remove Cell from Model                                      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I REMOVE_COLUMN                 Remove Column from Model                                    .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I REMOVE_NODE                   Remove node and its subtree from model                      .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I SET_CELL_VALUE                view, set new cell value                                    .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I SET_COLUMN_VALUE              View, set new column value                                  .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I SET_NODE_VALUE                view, set new node text                                     .
IF_UAC_TREE_MODEL              I SET_VALUE_PROVIDER            Set call back for 'get/set_item_value' methods              .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I ADD_CELL_STYLE                Add Style Properties for Cells                              .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I ADD_COLUMN_STYLE              add style properties for columns                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I ADD_NODE_STYLE                add style properties for nodes                              .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I CHANGE_CELL_STYLE             change style properties for cells                           .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I CHANGE_COLUMN_STYLE           change style properties for columns                         .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I CHANGE_NODE_STYLE             change style properties for nodes                           .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_CELL_STYLE                view: get cell style data                                   .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_CELL_STYLE_ID             view: get style ID for cell                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_COLUMN_STYLE              view: get column style data                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_COLUMN_STYLE_ID           view: get style ID for column                               .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_NODE_STYLE                view: get node style data                                   .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I GET_NODE_STYLE_ID             view: get style ID for node                                 .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I QUERY                         Query this Interface                                        .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I RAISE_EVENT                   manually raise item_style_changed event                     .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I REFRESH                       refresh values of nodes, columns and cells                  .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_CELL_STYLE                Set style properties for cells                              .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_COLUMN_STYLE              Set style properties for columns                            .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_DEFAULT_CELL_STYLE        set default style properties of cells                       .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_DEFAULT_CELL_STYLE_FOR_COLset default style properties of cells on column             .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_DEFAULT_COLUMN_STYLE      set default style properties of columns                     .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_DEFAULT_NODE_STYLE        set default style properties of nodes                       .
IF_UAC_TREE_STYLE_MANAGER      I SET_NODE_STYLE                Set style properties for nodes                              .
IF_UAC_UNDO_COMMAND            I GET_REDO_STACK                Static: get stack with redoable commands                    .
IF_UAC_UNDO_COMMAND            I GET_UNDO_DESCRIPTION          Get description for Undo                                    .
IF_UAC_UNDO_COMMAND            I GET_UNDO_STACK                Static: get stack with undoable commands                    .
IF_UAC_UNDO_COMMAND            I REDO                          Redo this command (after undo)                              .
IF_UAC_UNDO_COMMAND            I UNDO                          Undo this command (after execute)                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I CHECK                         Check changed data                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I FREE                          Free view                                                   .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_GRID                      Get grid                                                    .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_GUI_CONTROL               get cl_gui_control                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_MODEL                     get model                                                   .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_PARENT_CONTAINER          get the parent control container                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_VIEW_ID                   get id of this view                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_VIEW_ITEM                 get current view item                                       .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_VIEW_STRATEGY_ID          get strategy id of this view                                .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I GET_VIEW_TYPE                 get type [grid|tree] of this view                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I HAS_ASSIGNMENT                view supports assignments with assignment column            .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I IS_EDITABLE                   is the view editable?                                       .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I IS_SHOWING                    is the view showing, (i.e. has SHOW( ) been called already)?.
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I IS_VISIBLE                    is the view visible?                                        .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I OPTIMIZE_COLUMN               optimize width of [single|all] column(s)                    .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I REFRESH                       refresh view, eventually with new view item                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I SET_EDITABLE                  set the editability of the view                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I SET_VISIBLE                   set visibility of view                                      .
IF_UAC_VIEW                    I SHOW                          call SHOW to start displaying, model must be initialized!   .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I ACTIVATE_DISPLAY_PROTOCOL     Output Log in Dialog                                        .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I ACTIVATE_REPREP_INTERFACE     Enable Report/Report Interface                              .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I APPEND_ROWS                   Append Rows at End                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I CELL_DISPLAY                  Output Cell                                                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I CHANGE_DATA_FROM_INSIDE       for internal use only!                                      .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check Changes and Fire Event DATA_CHANGED                   .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I FCODE_BOUNCER                 Internal, Temporary, Do not Use!                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_ACTUAL_VIEW               Gets Current View                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_BACKEND_FIELDCATALOG      INTERNAL USE ONLY                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_CURRENT_CELL              Current Row                                                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_FILTERED_ENTRIES          Hash Table of Filtered Entries                              .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_FILTER_CRITERIA           Get Filter Criteria                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_FRONTEND_FIELDCATALOG     Get Current Field Catalog from Frontend                     .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_FRONTEND_LAYOUT           Get Current Layout from Frontend                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_FRONTEND_PRINT            Get Current Print from Frontend                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SCROLL_INFO_VIA_ID        Use ID to Get Scroll Information                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SELECTED_CELLS            Get Selected Cells                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SELECTED_CELLS_ID         Get Selected Cell IDs                                       .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Get Selected Columns                                        .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Get Selected Rows                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SORT_CRITERIA             Get Sort Criteria                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_SUBTOTALS                 Get Subtotals Table                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I GET_VARIANT                   Get Layout                                                  .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I IS_READY_FOR_INPUT            Check for Current Editibility                               .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I LIST_PROCESSING_EVENTS        Interface Method Classic ALV to ALV Control                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I OFFLINE                       Batch or Web Reporting                                      .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I PROCESS_UCOMM_ON_INVALID_INPUTUcomms To Be Processed Even in Case of Invalid Input        .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I RAISE_EVENT                   Raise 'USER_COMMAND'                                        .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I REFRESH_TABLE_DISPLAY         Redisplay Table                                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I REGISTER_DELAYED_EVENT        Set Delayed Event (change_selection or moved_cell)          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I REGISTER_EDIT_EVENT           Register Edit Events                                        .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I REGISTER_F4_FOR_FIELDS        Register F4 Handling for Fields                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SAVE_GRID_VARIANTS_SIMUL      Save Grid Variants with Current                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SAVE_VARIANT                  Save Layout                                                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SAVE_VARIANT_DARK             Save Variant in Background                                  .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SELECT_TEXT_IN_CURR_CELL      Select Text                                                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_3D_BORDER                 Sets 3D Frame                                               .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_AUTOREDRAW                Autoredraw                                                  .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_CURRENT_CELL_VIA_ID       Current Row                                                 .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_DELTA_CELLS               For Internal Use Only!!                                     .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_DROP_DOWN_TABLE           Set Dropdown Table                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_ERROR_LOG                 For Internal Use Only!!                                     .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_FILTER_CRITERIA           Set Filter Conditions                                       .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_FRONTEND_FIELDCATALOG     Set Field Catalog                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_FRONTEND_LAYOUT           Set Frontend Layout                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_FRONTEND_PRINT            Set Frontend Print                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_FUNCTION_CODE             Internal Use Only!                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_GRAPHICS_CONTAINER        Pass Graphic Container                                      .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_GRIDTITLE                 Pass Grid Title                                             .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_HEADER_TRANSPORT          For Internal Use only!                                      .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_HTML_HEADER               Excel Header Set                                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_LAYOUT_OF_DOUBLEGRID      Configures the Double Grid for the Layout (DV)              .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_READY_FOR_INPUT           Set/Reset Ready for Input Status                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SCROLL_INFO_VIA_ID        Use ID to Set Scroll Information                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SELECTED_CELLS            Set Cell Selections                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SELECTED_CELLS_ID         Set Cell Selections                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SELECTED_COLUMNS          Set Column Selections                                       .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SELECTED_ROWS             Set Selected Rows                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_SORT_CRITERIA             Set Sort Criteria                                           .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_TABLE_FOR_FIRST_DISPLAY   Formatted Output Table is Sent to Control                   .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_TOOLBAR_INTERACTIVE       Set Toolbar Status                                          .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_USER_COMMAND              Set User Command                                            .
IF_UAC_VIEW_GRID               I SET_VARIANT                   Set Display Variant                                         .
IF_UAC_VIEW_STRATEGY           I GET_INSTANCE                  called by factory, get instance of view                     .
IF_UAC_VIEW_STRATEGY           I GET_VIEW_STRATEGY_ID          get strategy id of this view                                .
IF_UAP_FIELD_STEERING          I GET_FIELDNAMES                Supply Field Names for a Certain Status                     .
IF_UAP_FIELD_STEERING          I GET_REFERENCE                 For Field Symbol                                            .
IF_UAP_FIELD_STEERING          I GET_STATUS                    Read Field Status                                           .
IF_UAP_FIELD_STEERING          I REFINE_STATUS                 Set Field Status                                            .
IF_UAP_FIELD_STEERING          I SET_CONTEXT                   Set Context                                                 .
IF_UAP_PREFERENCES             I ADJUST_TREE_EXTENSION         Adjust Width                                                .
IF_UAP_PREFERENCES             I GET_FLAGS                     Determine Indicator                                         .
IF_UAP_PREFERENCES             I SWITCH_TREE_VISIBILITY        Display Tree?                                               .
IF_UAP_USER_COMMAND            I EXECUTE                       Execute Command                                             .
IF_UAP_USER_COMMAND            I IS_ACTIVE                     Test if OK Code is Active                                   .
IF_UASE_CONVERSION             I CMCS_TYPE_CODE_INBOUND        Convert CostModelCostSourceTypeCode to Object Type          .
IF_UASE_CONVERSION             I CMCS_TYPE_CODE_OUTBOUND       Convert Object Type to CostModelCostSourceTypeCode          .
IF_UASE_CONVERSION             I STATUS_CODE_OUTBOUND          Convert Satus Code to CostModelCostSourceLifeCycleStatusCode.
IF_UAV_CURRENCY_SERVICE        I NEW_CURRENCY_RATES            Reaction to New Exchange Rates                              .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I CHECK                         Check Time                                                  .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Check Immediately Before Save                               .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I DELETE                        Delete Time                                                 .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I ENRICH_TABLE                  Application-Specific Completion of Output Table             .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I EXECUTE_NAVIGATION            Event Handling                                              .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I GET_AUTH_OBJECT               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I GET_EVENTS                    Get Occurring Events                                        .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I GET_LAYOUT                    Get Information on Layout and Field Catalog                 .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I INIT                          Initialization and Check at Start                           .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I IS_DELETABLE                  Check for "Deletion Allowed"                                .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I REFRESH_DATA                  Delete Held Data                                            .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_UAV_PRICE_MAINTENANCE       I UPDATE                        Update Time                                                 .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_APPLICATION_TYPE          Gets Application Type: CoCo, VNA, ...                       .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_CHANGE                    Gets State of Indicator "Display/Change"                    .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_CHANGEABLE                Indicator: Can Application Switch to Change Mode            .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Gets Environment Object                                     .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_MVC_FOR_VIEW              Gets MVC Structure for Given View                           .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_TECHNICAL_MODE            Gets Value of Indicator "Technical Display"                 .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I GET_WORKSET                   Gets Working Environment of Application                     .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I INIT_CONTROLS                 Generates Screen Control                                    .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I MESSAGE                       Sends Messages to Screen                                    .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I ON_FCODE                      Handles OKCODE                                              .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I QUIT                          Exit application                                            .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I RECALCULATE                   Triggers New Calculation of Model                           .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I SET_APPLICATION               *** for Unit Testing only - DO NOT USE otherwise ***        .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I SET_CHANGE_MODE               Set Mode from Changes                                       .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I SET_DIRTY_FLAG                Sets/Deletes Indicator "Changes Exist"                      .
IF_UA_APPLICATION              I SET_TECHNICAL_MODE            Sets or Deletes Indicator for Technical Display             .
IF_UA_CCS_VALUES               I GET_ALL_CCS_VALUES            Gets All Values of a Key Figure of an Element               .
IF_UA_CCS_VALUES               I GET_CCS_IDS                   Gets All Cost Component Splits that Exist for an Element    .
IF_UA_CCS_VALUES               I GET_CCS_VALUES                Gets All Values of Key Figure for Cost Component Split      .
IF_UA_CCS_VALUES               I REFRESH_CCS_VALUES            Deletes Split Values of an Element                          .
IF_UA_CCS_VALUES               I SET_CCS_VALUES                Gets All Values of Key Figure for Cost Component Split      .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_APPLICATION_TYPE          Delivers Application Type: CoCo, VNA, ...                   .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_CONTEXT                   Delivers Context                                            .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_EDGE_TYPE                 TEMP -" Metadata                                            .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_ENTRY_POINT               Get entry node for calculation                              .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_FORMULA                   TEMP                                                        .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_LEVEL_CONDITION           Delivers Level Condition                                    .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_NODE_TYPE                 TEMP -" Metadata                                            .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_RESULT_LEVEL              Delivers Result Level                                       .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I IS_DIRTY                      Delivers 'X', if changes exist and are to be saved          .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I SAVE                          Save all parts of the Costing Engine to be made persistent  .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I SET_CONTEXT                   Sets Context                                                .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I SET_LEVEL_CONDITION           Sets Level Condition                                        .
IF_UA_CE_ENVIRONMENT           I SET_MODEL_CONDITION           Sets Model Condition                                        .
IF_UA_CE_STATUS                I ADD_STATUS_TRANSITION         Add Status Transfer                                         .
IF_UA_CE_STATUS                I CREATE_STATUS_TRANSITIONS     Generates Status Transfer Table                             .
IF_UA_CE_STATUS                I GET_STATUS_TRANSITION         Delivers Status Transfer                                    .
IF_UA_CE_STATUS                I IS_DB_STATUS_DIRTY            'X' = Changes Exist, Save Necessary                         .
IF_UA_CHECK_STRATEGY           I CHECK                         Execute Checks                                              .
IF_UA_COMMAND_LISTENER         I EXECUTED                      Command Executed                                            .
IF_UA_CONTROLLER               I ENFORCE_OBLIGATORY_FIELD      Forces Entry of a Required Entry Field                      .
IF_UA_CONTROLLER               I ENFORCE_PERMITTED_KEY         Forces Entry of a Valid Key                                 .
IF_UA_CONTROLLER               I GET_FCODE_PREFIX              Delivers Unique Function Code Prefix                        .
IF_UA_CONTROLLER               I REJECT_DUPLICATE_NODE         Rejects Insertion of a Duplicated Node                      .
IF_UA_CONTROLLER               I TAKE_OVER_OBJECT              Transfer Existing Object, After Confirmation                .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I DEL                           Delete fields                                               .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I GET                           Read Fields                                                 .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I GET_ALL                       Delivers All Fields of Context                              .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I GET_FIELD                     Delivers Field whose Name Was Entered                       .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I GET_GROUP                     Delivers Fields whose Group Was Entered                     .
IF_UA_CR_CONTEXT               I SET                           Set Fields                                                  .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I ENRICH_FINB_MSG_HANDLER       Transfers a FINB Message Handler into Default Handler       .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_CONTEXT                   Gets Context of Costing Run                                 .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_CRUN_ID                   Gets ID of Costing Run                                      .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_DATABASIS                 Gets Data Basis                                             .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_METADATA                  Gets Metadata                                               .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_RESULT_LEVEL              Gets Result Level                                           .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I GET_WORKLIST_ID               Gets KPEP Worklist ID                                       .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I LOG_BAPIRETTAB                Logs Table with Messages in Format BAPIRET2                 .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I MONITOR_CLOSE                 Closes Monitor                                              .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I MONITOR_OPEN                  Generates and Initializes Monitor                           .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I ROOT_SET                      Sets Root Nodes of Environment                              .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I SAVE                          Save                                                        .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_AS_TABLE             Worklist as Table                                           .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_CLOSE                Closes Worklist                                             .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_CREATE               Generates Worklist                                          .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_OPEN                 Opens Worklist                                              .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_READ                 Reads an Item from Worklist                                 .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_SET_STATUS           Sets the Status of an Item in Worklist                      .
IF_UA_CR_ENVIRONMENT           I WORKLIST_WRITE                Writes an Item in Worklist                                  .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_KPEP_WL_ATTRIB01          Field of Structure KPEP_WL_NEWOBJINF                        .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_KPEP_WL_ATTRIB02          Field of Structure KPEP_WL_NEWOBJINF                        .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_KPEP_WL_OBJECT            Field of Structure KPEP_WL_NEWOBJINF                        .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_KPEP_WL_OBJID             Field of Structure KPEP_WL_NEWOBJINF                        .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_UAB_DESCRIPTION           Description from View of Costing Platform                   .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_UAB_ID                    ID of Item from Costing Platform View                       .
IF_UA_CR_WORKLIST_ITEM         I GET_UAB_TYPE                  Category of Item from Costing Platform View                 .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_EDGE                   Costing Engine API: Generate Link                           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_EDGE_WITH_REFERENCE    Costing Engine API: Generate Link                           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_HIER_EDGE              Costing Engine API: Generate Hierarchy Link                 .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_HIER_OBJECT            Costing Engine API:  Generate Structure Object              .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_HIER_OBJECT_W_REF      Costing Engine API:  Generate Structure Object              .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_NODE                   Costing Engine API: Generate Node                           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_OBJECT                 Costing Engine API: Generate Object                         .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_TLINE                  Costing Engine API: Generate Table Line                     .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_CREATE           I CREATE_TREE_NODE              Costing Engine API:  Generate Tree Nodes                    .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_ALL_REFERENCES         Delete All References of an Object                          .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_EDGE                   Delete Link                                                 .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_ELEMENT                Delete Any Element                                          .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Nodes                                                .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_OBJECT                 Delete Object                                               .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_TLINE                  Delete Table Entry                                          .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_DELETE           I DELETE_TREE_NODE              Delete Nodes                                                .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_EXIST            I EXIST                         Reads Elements Using Complex Selection Conditions           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_EXIST            I EXIST_SINGLE                  Reads Individual Element Using Key                          .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_EXIST            I EXIST_SINGLE_MULTI            Reads Multiple Elements Using Key                           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_SELECT           I SELECT                        Reads Elements Using Complex Selection Conditions           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_SELECT           I SELECT_AUTHORIZED             Reads Elements Using Complex Selection Conditions           .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_SELECT           I SELECT_SINGLE                 Reads Individual Element Using Key                          .
IF_UA_ELEMENT_SELECT           I SELECT_SINGLE_MULTI           Reads Multiple Elements Using Key                           .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I DEQUEUE_ALL                   Unlock All Elements                                         .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I DEQUEUE_ELEMENT               Unlock Individual Element                                   .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I ENQEUE_SPECIFIC               Set Specific Lock                                           .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I ENQUEUE_ELEMENT               Lock Individual Element                                     .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I ENQUEUE_ELEMENTS              Lock Several Elements (Generic)                             .
IF_UA_ENQUEUE_SERVICE          I ENQUEUE_ELEMENT_VAL_TAB       Lock Individual/Generic by Value Table for Element Types    .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I GET_DROPDOWN_MENU             GET_DROPDOWN_MENU                                           .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_CELL_DOUBLE_CLICK          ON_CELL_DOUBLE_CLICK                                        .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_CELL_DROPDOWN_SELECTED     ON_CELL_DROPDOWN_SELECTED                                   .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_CELL_KEYPRESSED            ON_CELL_KEYPRESSED                                          .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_CELL_SELECTED              ON_CELL_SELECTED                                            .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_COLUMN_DOUBLE_CLICK        ON_COLUMN_DOUBLE_CLICK                                      .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_COLUMN_ORDER_CHANGED       ON_COLUMN_ORDER_CHANGED                                     .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DRAG                       ON_DRAG                                                     .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE              ON_DRAG_MULTIPLE                                            .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DROP                       ON_DROP                                                     .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DROP_COMPLETE              ON_DROP_COMPLETE                                            .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DROP_COMPLETE_MULTIPLE     ON_DROP_COMPLETE_MULTIPLE                                   .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_DROP_GET_FLAVOR            ON_DROP_GET_FLAVOR                                          .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_MULTI_SELECTION_CHANGE     ON_MULTI_SELECTION_CHANGE                                   .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_NODE_DOUBLE_CLICK          ON_NODE_DOUBLE_CLICK                                        .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_NODE_KEYPRESSED            ON_NODE_KEYPRESSED                                          .
IF_UA_EVENT_HANDLER_STRATEGY   I ON_SORT_ORDER_CHANGED         ON_SORT_ORDER_CHANGED                                       .
IF_UA_FORMULA_FUNCTION_CHECKS  I CHECK_RETURN_TYPE             Checks whether the Function Could Deliver a Certain Type    .
IF_UA_FORMULA_FUNCTION_CHECKS  I CHECK_RETURN_TYPEKIND         Checks whether the Function Could Deliver a Certain Type Cat.
IF_UA_FORMULA_FUNCTION_CHECKS  I GET_FUNCTION                  Gets All Functions that the Class Offers                    .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I GET_CHAR_FACTORY              get if_ug_md_factory                                        .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I GET_TECHNICAL_MODE            X = true: display technical descriptions                    .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I QUERY_FORMULA_BUILD_ENV       Query cl_ua_formula_build_env                               .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I QUERY_MODEL                   Query if_uac_tree_model                                     .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I QUERY_STYLE_MANAGER           Query if_uac_tree_style_manager                             .
IF_UA_FORMULA_GUI_TREE         I QUERY_VIEW                    Query if_uac_gui_tree                                       .
IF_UA_FORMULA_QUAN_CONVERTER   I GET_TARGET_BASE_UNIT          Delivers Ref. Unit of Measure which Should Have the Result  .
IF_UA_FORMULA_QUAN_CONVERTER   I GET_TARGET_UNIT               Delivers the Unit which Should Have the Result of Formula   .
IF_UA_FORMULA_RT_ENVIRONMENT   I GET_GENERIC_TABLE_STRUCTURE   Delivers Structure of a Variable or Return Value            .
IF_UA_FORMULA_RT_ENVIRONMENT   I GET_RESULT_BASE_QNTY          Delivers Base Quantity of Return Value                      .
IF_UA_FORMULA_RT_ENVIRONMENT   I GET_VALUE                     Delivers Value of a Variable                                .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HISTORIC_PRICE            Gets Historic Price Table Entry (Valid-On Systematics)      .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HISTORIC_PRICES           Gets Multiple Historic Price Table Entries                  .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HISTORIC_PRICES_BY_KEY    Gets Historical Price Table Entries for Key Values          .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HISTORY_FIELDS            Gets Fields of History Table for Price Type                 .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HISTORY_KEY_FIELDS        Gets Key Fields of History Table                            .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_HIST_PRICES_BY_PART_KEY   Gets Multiple History Table Entries for Partial Keys        .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_PRICE                     Gets a Price Table Entry (Valid-On Systematics)             .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_PRICES                    Gets Multiple Price Table Entries                           .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_PRICES_BY_KEY             Gets Multiple Price Table Entries for Key Values            .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I GET_PRICES_BY_PARTIAL_KEY     Gets Multiple Price Table Entries for Subkey Values         .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEREADER_ONLY I REFRESH_BUFFER                Resets Runtime Buffer of Price Tables                       .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I CANCEL_CHANGE                 Undo Price Changes                                          .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I DELETE_PRICE                  Delete Existing Price                                       .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I GET_RUNTIME_TABLE             Reads Contents of Runtime Buffer of Price Table Entries     .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I INSERT_PRICE                  Add New Price                                               .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I MODIFY_PRICE                  If Price Exists, Change It. Otherwise Insert                .
IF_UA_GENERIC_PRICEWRITER_ONLY I UPDATE_PRICE                  Change Existing Price                                       .
IF_UA_INV_ACC_ASSIGN_CHECK     I CHECK_ASSIGNMENT              Check Account Assignment                                    .
IF_UA_INV_ACC_ASSIGN_REPLACE   I REPLACE_ASSIGNMENT            Replace Account Assignment                                  .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_EXT_MARKET_PRICE I GET_MARKET_PRICES             Read Market Prices from Sources                             .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_HANDLE_ASSIGNING I FILL_LAYER1_ASSIGNMENT_TABLES Fill Assignment Tables Layer1                               .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_HANDLE_ASSIGNING I FILL_LAYER2_ASSIGNMENT_TABLES Fill Assignment Tables Layer2                               .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_HANDLE_ASSIGNING I FILL_LAYER3_ASSIGNMENT_TABLES Fill Assignment Tables Layer3                               .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_INT_LAYER        I READ_INTERMEDIATE_LAYER       Reads Intermediate Layers                                   .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_PAFW_METHODS     I SPECIALIZE_SELECTION          Specialize Selection for Transaction Data                   .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_PROCEDURES       I CALCULATE_PRICE               Calculates the price                                        .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_RULE_SPECIFIC    I CHECK_ON_CHANGE_SPECIFIC      Check Changes to a Rule (Depends on Procedure)              .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_RULE_SPECIFIC    I DELETE_SPECIFIC               Delete a Rule (Depends on Procedure)                        .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_RULE_SPECIFIC    I SELECT_SPECIFIC               Read a Rule (Depends on Procedure)                          .
IF_UA_INV_BSV_RULE_SPECIFIC    I UPDATE_SPECIFIC               Update a Rule (Depends on Procedure)                        .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I BUILD_DELTA                   Calculate Delta from Data Read and Determined               .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I FILTER_FIN_OBJECTS            Filter FIN Object Instances                                 .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I GET_DOC_READER                Reader for Displaying Source Documents                      .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I GET_EVENTS_TO_SHOW_BY_PEC     Events of Period-End Closing                                .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I PROCESS_DATA                  Processing of Data                                          .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I SPECIALIZE_SELECTION          Selection of Specialized Transaction Data                   .
IF_UA_INV_PROCESSOR            I SPLIT_DATA                    Separate Data into Basic Data and Old Results               .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I ADD_MSG                       Message Transferred to Content                              .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I ADD_MSG_TABLE                 Table with Messages Transferred to Content                  .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I ADD_SY_MSG                    Messages with SYMSG Transferred to Content                  .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I CHANGE_AT_FETCH               Changing and Adding Lines                                   .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I CHANGE_SELTAB                 Change to Selection Table in Journal Reader if Needed       .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I CONVERT_AT_FETCH              Conversion at Event 'FETCH' of Journal Reader               .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I GET_CHECK_ACCSYS_FROM_SELTAB  Check Selection                                             .
IF_UA_INV_READER_CONTENT       I SPLIT_SELECTION               Split Selections for Multireader; Before CHANGE_SELTAB      .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I CHECK_ALL_AT_SAVE             Check Rules                                                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I CHECK_AT_EDIT                 Check Rules                                                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I CHECK_SENDER_AT_EDIT          Check Sender Rule Only                                      .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I DISTRIBUTION_BADI             Call Application-Specific BAdI in Processing                .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I ENHANCE_SETTLEMENT_RULE       Enrich Receivers in Distribution                            .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I ENRICH_DATA_ON_DELETE         Enrich List Display Structure When Changing                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I ENRICH_DATA_ON_INSERT         Enrich List Display Structure When Changing                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I ENRICH_DATA_ON_UPDATE         Enrich List Display Structure When Changing                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I ENRICH_RECEIVER_DISPLAY       Enrich Maintenance Structure for Settlement Rule            .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I EXECUTE_NAVIGATION            Callback from Reporting Tool                                .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_AUTHORITY_CHECK           Authorization Check                                         .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_DEFAULT_RULE              Create Settlement Rule (Default)                            .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_EVENTS                    Gets Events (Navigation and Further User Guidance)          .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns Instance of Application Class                       .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_LAYOUT                    Layout for Sender and Receiver                              .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I GET_RULE_AT_DISTRIBUTION      Settlement Rule During Distribution                         .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I INACCURACY_ASSIGNMENT         Distribution of Remaining Amount at the End                 .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I TRANSLATE_AFTER_DISTRIBUTION  Translation of Basic Data After Distribution                .
IF_UA_INV_STL_PROCEDURE        I TRANSLATE_BEFORE_DISTRIBUTION Translation of Basic Data Before Distribution               .
IF_UA_INV_VIEW_CONFIG          I HAS_CONTENT                   Configuration has been taken over                           .
IF_UA_INV_VIEW_CONFIG          I RELOAD_CONTENT                Configuration has been taken over again                     .
IF_UA_INV_WIP_CLEARING_CONTENT I DISPLAY_ACC_DOC               Display AC Documents                                        .
IF_UA_INV_WIP_CLEARING_CONTENT I POST                          Post WIP Clearing                                           .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I ADD_ROOT_ELEMENT              Adds a Root Node                                            .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I ADD_ROOT_ELEMENTS             Adds Table with Root Nodes                                  .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I CHANGE_NODE                   Swaps Element at View                                       .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I EXCHANGE_ELEMENT              Swaps Element at View                                       .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I EXCHANGE_ROOT_ELEMENT         Swaps a Root Node in Tree Specified                         .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_CHAR_INSTANCE             Gets if_ug_md_char from Characteristic Service              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_COLUMNS                   get columns for tree or for node                            .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_DND_BHVR_HANDLE_NODE      Gets Handle for Drag&Drop Behavior of Nodes                 .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_EDGE_IDS_FOR_ELEMENT      Gets All IDs for Links with Transferred Element             .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_EDGE_OBJECT               Gets Object to Link ID                                      .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_ELEMENT_FOR_CELL          Determine Element to a Cell                                 .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_ENVIRONMENT               Gets Environment that the Model Adapter Accesses            .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_IDS_FOR_ELEMENT           Gets All IDs for Tree Nodes with Transferred Element        .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_IDS_FOR_FIELDNAME         Gets All IDs for Columns with Transferred Element           .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_LEADING_ELEMENT           Gets Leading CE Element of View Node                        .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_MAP_ELEMENT               DO NOT USE ANYMORE! Use get_leading_element instead!        .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_MAP_UNIQUE_FIELDNAME      Service: get attributes for column                          .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_METATYPE_FOR_COLUMN       Gets Metatype for a Column                                  .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_NODES_REFERENCING_OBJECT  Gets All Nodes that Reference the Object Specified          .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_ROOT_ELEMENTS             Gets Root Elements of a Tree                                .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_ROOT_ELEMENTS_OF_TREES    Gets Root Elements of All Trees                             .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_STRATEGY                  Gets Used View Strategy                                     .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_TREENODE_ITERATOR         Gets Iterator over All Tree Nodes of Model                  .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_TREE_FOR_NODE             Delivers Tree ID for Transferred Tree NodeID                .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_TYPENAMES_FOR_COLUMN      Gets Table of Type Names for a Column                       .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_TYPES                     Gets Table of Types that Handle the Model Adapter           .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_VIEW_NAME                 Gets Logical Name of this View                              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I GET_VIRTUAL_ROOT_NODE_ID      Gets ID of Virtual Root Node of a Tree                      .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I HAS_ROOT_ELEMENT              Gets Root Elements of a Tree                                .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I IS_EDITABLE                   Editable Field                                              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I IS_KEY                        Key Field                                                   .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I IS_KNOWN_ELEMENT              Gets true = 'X', element is known to adapter                .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I IS_OBLIGATORY                 Required field                                              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I IS_ROOT_ELEMENT               'X' = Element is a root node in tree specified              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I ON_WORKSET_CHANGE             clear model, refresh with new workset                       .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I ON_WORKSET_CLOSE              close workset -" clear model                                .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I ON_WORKSET_OPEN               refresh model with new workset                              .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I REGISTER_EDGE                 Register CE Offsetting Link                                 .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I REGISTER_ELEMENT              Register CE Element as Node                                 .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I REMOVE_ROOT_ELEMENT           Deletes a Root Node from the Tree Specified                 .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I SET_TECHNICAL_MODE            Sets or Deletes Technical Display                           .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _COLUMN_SET_EDITABLE          TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _GET_MAP_FIELDNAME            TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _GET_MAP_NODE_ID              TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _GET_NODES_REFERENCING_OBJECT TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _IS_KEY                       TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_MODEL_ADAPTER            I _IS_KNOWN_ELEMENT             TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I ADD_EDGES_REF                 Add Links/Reference Transfer                                .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I ADD_EDGES_VAL                 Add Nodes/Value Transfer                                    .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I ADD_NODES_REF                 Add Nodes/Reference Transfer                                .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I ADD_NODES_VAL                 Add Nodes/Value Transfer                                    .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I CHANGE_NODE_DATA_REF          Add Nodes/Reference Transfer                                .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I CHANGE_NODE_DATA_VAL          Add Nodes/Value Transfer                                    .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I CHECK                         Check Network                                               .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I CLEAR_MESSAGES                Delete Messages                                             .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I DELETE_NODES                  Delete Nodes                                                .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I DELETE_SUBTREE                Delete Subtree                                              .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I GET_MESSAGES                  Retrieve Messages                                           .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I LOAD_FROM_DB_REF              Load Database Network/Reference Transfer                    .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I LOAD_FROM_DB_VAL              Load Database Network/Value Transfer                        .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I QUERY_NODE_REF                Determine Nodes/Reference Transfer                          .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I QUERY_NODE_VAL                Determine Nodes/Value Transfer                              .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I SAVE_TO_DB                    Save Network to Database                                    .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I SET_LEVEL_CONDITION           Set Posting Level                                           .
IF_UA_NETWORK                  I SOLVE                         Remove Network                                              .
IF_UA_PRICE_MANAGER_GENERAL    I GET_FIELDS                    Delivers Fields of Price Table to Price Label               .
IF_UA_PRICE_MANAGER_GENERAL    I GET_HISTORIC_FIELDS           Gets Fields of History Price Table to Price Label           .
IF_UA_PRICE_MANAGER_GENERAL    I GET_HISTORIC_KEY_FIELDS       Gets Key Fields of History Price Table                      .
IF_UA_PRICE_MANAGER_GENERAL    I GET_KEY_FIELDS                Delivers Key Fields of Price Table to Price Label           .
IF_UA_PRICE_READER             I GET_HISTORIC_PRICE            Gets Historic Price Table Entry for Key                     .
IF_UA_PRICE_READER             I GET_HISTORIC_PRICES           Gets Multiple Historic Price Table Entries                  .
IF_UA_PRICE_READER             I GET_PRICE                     Gets a Price Table Entry for Key                            .
IF_UA_PRICE_READER             I GET_PRICES                    Gets Multiple Price Table Entries (Valid-On Systematics)    .
IF_UA_PRICE_READER             I REFRESH_BUFFER                Resets Runtime Buffer of Price Tables                       .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I CANCEL_CHANGE                 Undo Price Changes                                          .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I DELETE_PRICE                  Delete Existing Price                                       .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I GET_RUNTIME_TABLE             Reads Contents of Runtime Buffer of Price Table Entries     .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I INSERT_PRICE                  Add New Price                                               .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I MODIFY_PRICE                  If Price Exists, Change It. Otherwise Insert                .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER             I UPDATE_PRICE                  Change Existing Price                                       .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER_STEPS       I PACKAGE_BEGIN                 Start Package Processing                                    .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER_STEPS       I PACKAGE_END                   End Package Processing                                      .
IF_UA_PRICE_WRITER_STEPS       I PACKAGE_SAVE                  Save Processing Package                                     .
IF_UA_PRICING_RESULT           I GET_PRICE                     Provide Result of Price Search in Price Structure           .
IF_UA_PRICING_RESULT           I GET_PRICING_RESULT            Provide Result of Price Search                              .
IF_UA_PRICING_STRATEGY         I EVALUATE                      Evaluates Valuation Strategy                                .
IF_UA_REPORTER                 I EXECUTE_REPORT                Execute Report                                              .
IF_UA_STRATEGY_MAINTENANCE     I GET_CLASSNAME                 Gets Class Name of ABAP Implementation                      .
IF_UA_STRATEGY_MAINTENANCE     I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Description of Valuation Strategy                      .
IF_UA_STRATEGY_MAINTENANCE     I GET_FORMULA                   Gets Formula for Valuation Strategy                         .
IF_UA_STRATEGY_MAINTENANCE     I GET_FORMULA_BUILD_ENV         Gets Build Environment for Formula                          .
IF_UA_STRATEGY_MAINTENANCE     I GET_QUAN_CONV_NAME            Gets Class Name of Unit Converter                           .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_EDGE                   Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_HIERARCHY_OBJECT       Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_NODE                   Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_OBJECT                 Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_TLINE                  Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_TREE_NODE              Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_TYPEABLE_FACTORY         I CREATE_TYPEABLE               Gets Instance of appropriate Element of Costing Engine      .
IF_UA_VALUATION_OBJECT         I GET_FIELD_NAMES               Gets List of Field Names of Valuation Object                .
IF_UA_VALUATION_OBJECT         I SET_VALUE                     Set Field Value on Valuation Object                         .
IF_UA_VALUATION_RESULT         I GET_QUANTITY_UNIT             Gets Valuation Unit of Measure                              .
IF_UA_VALUATION_RESULT         I GET_VALUATION_QUANTITY        Gets Valuation Quantity                                     .
IF_UA_VALUATION_RESULT         I GET_VALUATION_RESULT          Provide Valuation Result                                    .
IF_UA_VALUATION_STRATEGY       I EVALUATE                      Evaluates Valuation Strategy                                .
IF_UA_VIEW                     I REMOVE_WORKAREA               Delivers Work Area for a Tree                               .
IF_UA_VIEW                     I SHOW                          Brings View to Display                                      .
IF_UA_VIEW_FACTORY             I CREATE_MODEL_ADAPTER          Generates Model Adapter                                     .
IF_UA_VIEW_FACTORY             I CREATE_MVC                    Generates Model Adapter and View                            .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I CREATE_TREE_NODE              Create tree node                                            .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Elements                                             .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I DIALOG_TO_SET_FILTER          Open Filter Dialog                                          .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I ELEMENT_RENAME                Rename Element                                              .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I ENQUEUE_AND_AUTHORITY_CHECK   Authorization Check and Lock Element                        .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_DEFAULT_DRAGDROP          Gets Handle for Drag&Drop Behavior of Nodes                 .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_DEFINED_TREES             Gets Logical Name of Trees Defined in this View             .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_DND_BHVR_HANDLE_NODE      Gets Handle for Drag&Drop Behavior of Nodes                 .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_ID                        Delivers ID of Strategy                                     .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_IMPORT_EXCLUDE_TAB        View Elements, that are NOT Displayed at Import Agent       .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_PARENT_EDGE               Gets Link to Higher-Level Node from Tree Node ID            .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_PARENT_NODE               Gets Higher-Level Node from Tree Node ID                    .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_POSSIBLE_RECEIVERS        Gets Possible Receiver Nodes                                .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_POSSIBLE_SENDERS          Gets Possible Sender Nodes                                  .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_TREE_ID                   Gets Tree ID for Logical Tree Name                          .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_TREE_NAME                 Gets Logical Tree Name for Tree ID                          .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_TREE_TEXT                 Gets Heading for Hierarchy Column of Tree                   .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_VALUE                     Gets Contents of a Field to Element                         .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I GET_VIEW_NAME                 Gets Logical Name of a View                                 .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I HANDLE_CE_CHECK               Processes Costing Engine Check for an Element               .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I HANDLE_CE_EDGE_SEQUENCE       Link Sequence Was Changed                                   .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I HANDLE_CE_EVENT               Processes Costing Engine Event for an Element               .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I HANDLE_ELEMENT_CHANGE         Handles Change of Focus Element                             .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I IS_EDITABLE                   Is Field Ready for Input?                                   .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I IS_TYPE_ADDABLE               Gets TRUE = 'X' for Allowed Type                            .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I ON_WORKSET_CLOSE              close current workset -" clear, dequeue etc.                .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I ON_WORKSET_OPEN               refresh from new workset                                    .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I TOGGLE_TREE                   Show/Hide Tree                                              .
IF_UA_VIEW_STRATEGY            I _GET_OBLIGATORY_COLUMNS       TO BE DELETED                                               .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I COMMIT_EDGES                  Transfer Temporarily Stored Data to Costing Engine          .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I COMMIT_NODES                  Transfer Temporarily Stored Data to Costing Engine          .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I COMMIT_OBJECTS                Transfer Temporarily Stored Data to Costing Engine          .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I COMMIT_TLINES                 Transfer Temporarily Stored Data to Costing Engine          .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I INITIALIZE                    Read Types                                                  .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I PROCESS_EDGE                  Add Node                                                    .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I PROCESS_NODE                  Add Node                                                    .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I PROCESS_OBJECT                Add Object                                                  .
IF_UA_XML_MASS_IMPORT_HANDLER  I PROCESS_TLINE                 Add Table Line                                              .
IF_UC_ACC                      I GET_FIELDS                    Get Contained Fields                                        .
IF_UC_ACC                      I GET_FIELDS_DEFAULT_ON         Gets Fields with Default Flag "X"                           .
IF_UC_ACC                      I INIT                          Initialize Target Assignment                                .
IF_UC_ACC                      I IS_EQUAL                      Is the passed target assignment identical?                  .
IF_UC_ACC                      I IS_INITIAL                    Is Target Account Assignment Initial?                       .
IF_UC_ACC                      I SUBSTITUTE_ACCOUNT            Substitute target account assignment                        .
IF_UC_ACC                      I SUBSTITUTE_ACCOUNTS           Substitute target account assignments                       .
IF_UC_ACC                      I SUBSTITUTE_T_VALUE            Substitute Target Assignment in Value Table                 .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT                  I GET_ACC                       Get Instance of Matching Runtime Selection Object           .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT                  I IS_INITIAL                    Is target assignment empty?                                 .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I CREATE_HANDLE                 Get Handle for New Row in Fast Entry                        .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Layout and Data                                         .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I GET_MODEL                     Get Reference to Data Model                                 .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I GET_VALUE_FILTER_F4           Get filter for values displayed for F4                      .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I INDICATE_TEXT_DISPLAY_MODE    Called when text display is turned on or off                .
IF_UC_ACCOUNT_GUI_DATA         I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CHECK_CHAR_AUTHORITY          Check Authorization                                         .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CHECK_CHAR_EXISTENCE          Check if char. values exist                                 .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CHECK_CHAR_VALIDITY           Check if Char. Values Are Valid                             .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CHECK_SINGLE_CHAR_EXISTENCE   Check if Char. Value Exists                                 .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CHECK_SINGLE_CHAR_VALIDITY    Check if Char. Value Is Valid                               .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CONVERT_CHAR_INPUT            Convert to internal format                                  .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CONVERT_CHAR_OUTPUT           Convert to external format                                  .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CONVERT_SINGLE_CHAR_SID2VALUE Read SID for a Characteristic Value                         .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I CONVERT_SINGLE_CHAR_VALUE2SID Read Characteristic Value for a SID                         .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I GET_CHAR_FOR_UNIT             Get char. that determines currency key/unit of measure      .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I GET_FIELD_HRY_PROPERTIES      Get Field Properties Concerning Hierarchy                   .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Properties                                        .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get model instance                                          .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_CHAR_HRY                 Get Hier. Structure for a Characteristic                    .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_CHAR_HRYNAME             List of Available Hierarchies for a Characteristic          .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_CHAR_PROP                Read More Char.Values/Attributes/Texts                      .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_CHAR_SID                 Read SIDs for Char.Values                                   .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_CHAR_VALUE               Read char values/attr/texts                                 .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_SINGLE_CHAR_PROP         Read Characteristic Attributes/Texts for a Value            .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_TRANSACTION_DATA         Read transaction data w/field mapping                       .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I READ_TRANSACTION_DATA_UNMAPPEDRead transaction data w/o field mapping                     .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I REQUEST_CHAR_HELP             F1 help for char                                            .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I REQUEST_CHAR_VALUE            Poss.entries for char                                       .
IF_UC_APPLICATION_MODEL        I WRITE_TRANSACTION_DATA_DELTA  Write changes to trx data                                   .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_AREA_INSTANCE             Get Instance of a Cons Area                                 .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_CHAR_FOR_UNIT             Get Chars to Determine Units of Measure for Key Figures     .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_DATABASIS                 Get Data Basis                                              .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_DATASTREAM_PROPERTIES     Get Data Stream Attributes (Field Lists)                    .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get field attributes                                        .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES_TECH     Get Technical Field Attributes (for Generation)             .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_FIELD_VALIDITY_TYPES      Get Validity Types of Characteristics                       .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_GEN_OBJECTS_PHYS_NAME     Get physical name for current logical name                  .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_MD_FACTORY                Get Instance of Master Data Factory                         .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_MODEL                     Get model for current instance                              .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_MODEL_INSTANCE            Get Model for Given Cons Area                               .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_PARAMETER_FIELD           Global Parameters: Get Fields                               .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_REPUNITS                  Get Factory of Cons Unit Combinations                       .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_RESTRICTION               Get Value Restrictions of Model                             .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_STATUS_FIELD              Get status-rel. chars.                                      .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_TASK_STM_TIMESTAMP        Get Time Stamp Instance for Status-relevant Customizing     .
IF_UC_AREA                     I GET_VERSIONS                  Get Factory of Version Combinations                         .
IF_UC_AREA                     I IS_MULTIPROV_AVAILABLE        Is MultiProvider Available?                                 .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CALCULATE_ALL_KFIG            Compute All AFD Key Figures                                 .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CALCULATE_END_VALUE           Compute Ending Book Value                                   .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CALCULATE_RETIREMENT_CAP      Compute VALRA in Group Currency                             .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CALCULATE_RETIREMENT_VAL      Compute VALRD                                               .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CALCULATE_VALUE_ALLOWANCE     Compute Valuation Allowance                                 .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CHECK_ASSET_TIME              Check Time Stamps of Asset Master Data                      .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Create Data References for Interface Tables                 .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CREATE_DOCLN                  Create Doc.Line Items                                       .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I CREATE_PROPOSAL_ENTRIES       Create Default Values for Current Period                    .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I DERIVE_DEPRECIATION_SETTINGS  Derive Amortization (Depreciation) Parameters               .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I FINALIZATION                  Release Attributes                                          .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I FINALIZE_END_VALUE            Final Computation of Ending Book Value                      .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I GET_ASSET_ATTRIBUTE           Get BW Attributes of an Asset                               .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I INITIALIZATION                Read Master Data and Customizing                            .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I INITIALIZE_END_VALUE          Initialize Ending Book Value                                .
IF_UC_ASSET_MANAGER            I SELECT_AFD_FOR_ALTYPE         Select Data for Certain Asset Types                         .
IF_UC_CHAR_VALUE_FILTER        I REDUCE_LIST                   Reduce Entries in Value List                                .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I RECEIVE                       Get Sender Data                                             .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I SEND                          Write Sender Data                                           .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I SET_COIAC_REAL                Real OC Activity for OC Setup Activity                      .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I SET_COINR_ORIG                Activity Number of Triggering First Consolidation           .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I SET_HRY_OC_FLG                Indicator: OC Setup Activity for Hierarchy OC               .
IF_UC_COI_ACT_OC               I SET_INVOR_TRANSFER            Old and New Investor of OC Transfer                         .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_ALL             I GET_DATA_IO_INSTANCE          Get I/O Object                                              .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_ALL             I INIT                          Init. Instance                                              .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_ALL             I READ                          Read from Source Streams                                    .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG              I CHECK_FOR_EXISTING_FIN_DATA   Check for existing reported data in the group               .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG              I GET_CG_DATA                   Output group data                                           .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I CHANGE_CONS_FREQUENCY         Change of Cons Frequency: Move Goodwill Default Values      .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I CHANGE_LOCAL_CURRENCY         Local Currency Change                                       .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete Instance                                             .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I READ_GWA_FROM_DB              Read Goodwill Data for Group                                .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I RESTRICT_CG                   Restrict Data to a Group                                    .
IF_UC_COI_DATA_CG_SETUP        I SET_MIXED_MODE                Groups are processed in desired or predefined fashion       .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_DOCTYPE_CURRENT_TASK      Output Document Type for Current C/I Task                   .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_DOCUMENT_HEADER           C/I Document Header Data                                    .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_GW_GLOBAL_DECISION_FLG    Global Goodwill/Negative Goodwill Decision                  .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_GW_THRESHOLD_INVOR_FLG    Goodwill Threshold Value per Investor                       .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_NG_THRESHOLD_INVOR_FLG    Negative Goodwill Threshold Value per Investor              .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST            I GET_PREVIOUS_CONS_FREQ        Get Cons Frequency in Prior Period                          .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST_SETUP      I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete the Instance                                         .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST_SETUP      I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_CUST_SETUP      I SET_PARAM                     Update Parameters                                           .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_GROUP           I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete Instance                                             .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_GROUP           I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_COI_EXEC_GROUP           I PROCESS_GROUP                 Process a Group                                             .
IF_UC_COI_LOOP_ACT             I DELETE_INSTANCE               Delete Instance                                             .
IF_UC_COI_LOOP_ACT             I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_COI_LOOP_ACT             I LOOP_ACT                      Loop Through Activities                                     .
IF_UC_COI_PROCESS_SORT         I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_COI_PROCESS_SORT         I PROCESS_SORT                  Process Group Up to Activity Sort                           .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I ADJUST_GOODWILL_KFIG          Adjust Goodwill Key Figures                                 .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_ITEM_IS_PROTECTED       Checks if Item is Protected                                 .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_REP_ITEMS               Check Reported Items                                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_REP_ITEMS_EQI           Check Reported Items for Equity Method                      .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_REP_ITEMS_EQU           Check Reported Equity Items                                 .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_REP_ITEMS_INV           Check Reported Investment Items                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I CHECK_REP_ITEMS_PGW           Check Reported Push-down Items                              .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I EXTEND_PERIODS_IN_SEL         Extend Time Range in SEL from Period P to 0-P               .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_ACT_DEFAULT_EQU           Default Values for Equity                                   .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_ACT_DEFAULT_INV           Default Values for Investment                               .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_ACT_DEFAULT_SEQUENCE      Default Sequence for Activities                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_ACT_GWPROC                Goodwill Treatment in Acquisitions                          .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_APPROP_FLG                Appr. of Ret.Earnings in Balance Sheet or Income Statement? .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_APPROP_GROUP_ITEMS        Assignment of Equity Items to Statistical Items             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_APPROP_ITEMS              Appropriation of Retained Earnings Items                    .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_APPROP_MIN_ITEMS          Assignment of Equity Items to Statistical Items             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COINR                     Activity Numbers                                            .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COI_ACTIVE_FLG            Activate Consolidation of Investments                       .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COI_METHOD                Consolidation of Investments Methods                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COI_METHODS               Consolidation of Investments Methods                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COI_METHOD_ASSIGNMENT     Method Assignment                                           .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_COI_TASKS                 Consolidation of Investments Tasks                          .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_CVA_TASKS                 CVA Tasks                                                   .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_DIVINC_ITEMS              Items for Activity Distribution of Dividends                .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_DOCTY_CALC_BASIS          Posting Levels and Document Types                           .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_DOCTY_COI                 Document Types for Posting Level 30                         .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_DOCTY_DIVINC              Document Types for Elim. of Investment Income (Level 20)    .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_EQI_POST_ITEMS            Posting Items for Equity Method                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_EQI_SCOPES_INCOME         Scopes of Reported Data for Equity Method                   .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_EQUITY_AGING              Subitems for Statement of Stockholders' Equity              .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_EQU_MIN_ITEMS             Assignment of Equity Items to Minority Interest Items       .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_EQU_STAT_ITEMS            Assignment of Equity Items to Statistical Items             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GLOBAL_SETT               Global Settings                                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GLOBAL_SETT_GWA_ACC       Global Goodwill Items                                       .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GLOBAL_SETT_GWA_THRESHOLD Global Goodwill Threshold Values                            .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GLOBAL_SETT_GWA_TIME      Global Goodwill Settings                                    .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GLOBAL_SETT_HRA           Global Settings for Fair Value Adjustments                  .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GWLC_ACTIVE_FLG           Activation of "Goodwill in Local Currency"                  .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_GWRED_FLG                 Complete Reduction of Goodwill                              .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_INTDE_FLG                 Combined Entry                                              .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_NEXT_COINR                Next Activity Number                                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_OC_ACTIVE_FLG             Activation of Organizational Change                         .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_PGW_POST_ITEMS            Posting Items for Push-down Goodwill                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_POST_ITEMS_EQI            Posting Items for Equity Method                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_PRIOR_DATA_CONV           Legacy Data Transfer                                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_REP_ITEMS_EQI             Reported Items for Equity Method                            .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_REP_ITEMS_EQU             Reported Items for Changes in Equity                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_REP_ITEMS_INV             Reported Items for Changes in Investments                   .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_REP_ITEMS_PGW             Reported Items for Push-down Method                         .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_RET_EARNING_ITEMS         Items for Net Income                                        .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_SINGLE_COI_TASK           Single C/I Task                                             .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_SPECIAL_ITEMS             Selected Items                                              .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I GET_SYSTEM_UTIL               System Utilization                                          .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I IS_OC_RELEVANT                Relevance of Investment Data for Organizational Change      .
IF_UC_COI_SERVICES             I REMOVE_COINR                  Delete Activity Number                                      .
IF_UC_COI_SORT_ACT             I CONVERT_SORTSTATUS            Local "=" Global Sort                                       .
IF_UC_COI_SORT_ACT             I GET_ACT_SEQUENCE              Output Global Sequence of Activities (for Maintenance)      .
IF_UC_COI_SORT_ACT             I GET_ACT_SEQUENCE_2            Output Global Sequence of Activities (for Maintenance)      .
IF_UC_COI_SORT_ACT             I IS_COHERENT                   Global =" Local Sequence Without Loss of Information?       .
IF_UC_COI_WB_SERVICES          I GET_INACTIVE_WB_ENTRIES       Get all hidden entries in workbench                         .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check Existence of Combinations                             .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I CHECK_SINGLE_EXISTENCE        Check Existence of One Combination                          .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I CHECK_VALIDITY                Check Validity of Combinations                              .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Create Data Reference                                       .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I READ_SID                      Get SIDs                                                    .
IF_UC_COMBINATION              I READ_VALUE                    Get char values                                             .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I COPY_COMMENT_FOR_ANM          Mass Copying of Comments in ANM Process                     .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I COPY_COMMENT_WITH_NEW_ATTR    Copies Comments Acc. to Selection, and Sets New Attributes  .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I DELETE_COMMENT                Deletes a Comment in the Database                           .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I DEL_COMMENTS_WITH_SELECTION   Deletes All Existing Comments in the Selection              .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I GET_COMMENT                   Gets Content of a Comment in the Selection                  .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I GET_LOCK_STATE                Read Current Status of Lock Flag for a Comment              .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I LIST_COMMENTS_FOR_SELECTION   Gets List of All Comments in the Selection                  .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I LOCK_COMMENT                  Locks Comment to Prevent Changes                            .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I UNLOCK_COMMENT                Revokes Write Lock for a Comment                            .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I UPDATE_COMMENT                Changes a Comment in the Database                           .
IF_UC_COMMENT                  I UPDATE_COMMENT2               Changes a Comment in the Database                           .
IF_UC_COMMENT_APPLICATION      I SET_APPL_ATTR                 Set hosting application attributes(e.g. AFD/manual posting) .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_ACCOUNT         I ADD_FIELDS                    Add available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_ACCOUNT         I GET_ACCOUNT                   Get entire selcond/assignment for compound                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_ACCOUNT         I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_ACCOUNT         I LOAD                          Load (Another) Target Assignment                            .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_ACCOUNT         I SET_FIELDS                    Set available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_GUI             I CHECK                         Check subcomponents and inheritance                         .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_GUI             I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get GUI data (et_ empty: no change)                         .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_GUI             I SET_GUI_DATA                  Rewrite Display-Related Data                                .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_INT             I CHANGE_ALLOWED_SELACCTYPES    Change allowed sel/asgt types                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_INT             I GET_SELACCTYPE                Get entered sel/asgt types                                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_INT             I REMOVE_FIELDS                 Remove available characteristics                            .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_INT             I SET_ALLOWED_SELACCTYPES       Set allowed sel/asgt types                                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I ADD_FIELDS                    Add available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I CHANGE_INHERITANCE            Inherit characteristics from other compounds                .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I CHANGE_SUBCOMP_EDIT           Change  changability of subcomponents                       .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I CHANGE_SUBCOMP_VALUE          Change  values of subcomponents                             .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I GET_INHERITANCE               Get inheritance information                                 .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I GET_PART_SUBCOMP              Changable Subcompound: Get values of subcomponents          .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I GET_SELACC                    Get entire selcond/assignment for compound                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I SET_FIELDS                    Set available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I SET_INHERITANCE               Inherit characteristics from other compounds                .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_METHOD_STEP     I SET_SUBCOMP_EDIT              Set changability of subcomponents                           .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELACC          I ADD_FIELDS                    Add available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELACC          I GET_SELACC                    Get entire selcond/assignment for compound                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELACC          I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELACC          I SET_FIELDS                    Set available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I ADD_FIELDS                    Add available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I CHANGE_SUBCOMP_EDIT           Change  changability of subcomponents                       .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I CHANGE_SUBCOMP_VALUE          Change  values of subcomponents                             .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I GET_PART_SUBCOMP              Changable Subcompound: Get values of subcomponents          .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I GET_SELCOND                   Get entire selcond/assignment for compound                  .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I LOAD                          Load (Another) Selection Condition                          .
IF_UC_COMPOUND_SELCOND         I SET_FIELDS                    Set available characteristics                               .
IF_UC_CROSS_UNIT               I GET_CROSS_UNIT_FIELD          Get Org Unit Fields Changed by the Function                 .
IF_UC_CTR_DATA_EXT             I CALCULATE_TOTAL               Summarize Data Records                                      .
IF_UC_CTR_DATA_EXT             I GET_CHAR_VALUES               Get Char.Values from Current Data Record                    .
IF_UC_CTR_DATA_EXT             I GET_KFIG_VALUES               Get Key Figure Values from Current Data Record              .
IF_UC_CUST_ACCOUNT_GUI         I DEL_ACC_GUI                   Delete Assignment Screen Reference in GUI Class             .
IF_UC_CUST_ACCOUNT_GUI         I GET_ACC_GUI                   Get Assignment Screen Reference from GUI Class              .
IF_UC_CUST_ACCOUNT_GUI         I REGISTER_OBJECT               Register object                                             .
IF_UC_CUST_ACCOUNT_GUI         I SET_ACC_GUI                   Store Assignment Screen Reference in GUI Class              .
IF_UC_CUST_CHECK               I CHECK                         Check Consistency of Customizing Settings                   .
IF_UC_CUST_CHECK               I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I COMMIT                        Curr. state committed, rollback changes (w/o uO)            .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I COPY                          copy state of object from template obj (with nwvu0)         .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I DISCARD_UNDO                  "Forget" oldest change to the object (w/o u0)               .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I FINALIZE_CHANGES              Finish Changes, Prepare Object for Commit                   .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I GET_DESCRIPTION               Get descr. text for obj                                     .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I GET_GUID                      Get GUID of obj                                             .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I ROLLBACK                      Rollback all changes since last Commit (w/o u0)             .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I SAVE                          Write changes to object in the database (w/o u0)            .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I SET_FFIX                      Set Fixed Characteristic Values                             .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I UNDO                          Undo last change to object (w/o u0)                         .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA                I UNDO_ALL                      Undo all changes (w/o u0)                                   .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA_EXT            I CHECK                         Check Customizing Object (incl. lower-level objects)        .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA_EXT            I DELETE                        Flag Cust. obj. for deletion (incl. non-reusable u0)        .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA_EXT            I GET_TEXT                      Get the descriptive text                                    .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA_EXT            I SET_TEXT                      Set the descriptive text                                    .
IF_UC_CUST_DATA_EXT            I TRANSPORT                     Get transport info for CustObject                           .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY             I GET_INSTANCE_BY_GUID          Get instance via GUID                                       .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY             I TRANSPORT_BY_GUID             Transport all objects for sel.cond. for given GUIDs         .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY_EXT         I CHECK                         Check all instancized Customizing Objects                   .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY_EXT         I CREATE                        Create a Customizing Object                                 .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY_EXT         I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance of an existing Customizing Object              .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY_EXT         I GET_LIST                      Get a list of all existing objects                          .
IF_UC_CUST_FACTORY_EXT         I TRANSPORT_BY_SEMKEY           Transport all objects of sel.cond. for semantic key         .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I CALL_PAI_COMMAND              Pass the OK code                                            .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I CALL_PBO_BEFORE               Call during PBO before CALL SUBSCREEN                       .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I FREE                          Release GUI Object (release controls)                       .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance No. "n"                                        .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I LOAD                          Load Customizing Object into the GUI object                 .
IF_UC_CUST_GUI_EXT             I UNLOAD                        Remove Current Cust. Object from GUI Object                 .
IF_UC_CUST_PRINT               I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_UC_CUST_PRINT               I GET_LIST_NUMBER               get list number, used for list structure                    .
IF_UC_CUST_PRINT               I PRINT_LP                      Output of List                                              .
IF_UC_CUST_PRINT               I PRINT_LP_GET_STRUCT           Output Structure for List Structure                         .
IF_UC_CUST_TRANSPORT           I TRANSPORT_BY_GUID             Transport all objects for sel.cond. for given GUIDs         .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_ACC                    Create target assignment                                    .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_FIELD                  Generate Field List                                         .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_FIELD_ATTR             Generate Field List Attribute List                          .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_FIELD_SEQUENCE         Generate Field List with Relevant Sequence                  .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_HRY                    Create (Partial) Hierarchy                                  .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_HRY_TI                 Create Time-Dependent (Partial) Hierarchy                   .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_SEL                    Create selection condition                                  .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA                Create trans. data object                                   .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA_BUFFER         Create buffer for trx data object                           .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA_CHANGE         Generate Object for Transaction Data Change                 .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA_INT            Datamanager internal (only for use by buffer object)        .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA_IO_TYPE        Generate Data Stream Type                                   .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I CREATE_TX_DATA_STREAM         Create data stream                                          .
IF_UC_DATA_FACTORY             I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance of factory                                     .
IF_UC_DEFVAL_GUI_DATA          I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_DEFVAL_GUI_DATA          I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_DEFVAL_GUI_DATA          I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I CHECK_HEADER_MODIFIABLE       Check whether the header is modifiable                      .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I CHECK_NEWROWS                 Check the newly inserted rows                               .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I CHECK_TXDATA_NEWROW           Check the transaction data for new row                      .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I CHECK_TX_DATA                 Check whether the transaction data is valid                 .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I CHECK_VALID_CHARVALUE         Check whether the value of a char is valid                  .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I GET_NEWROW                    Get all the new row information                             .
IF_UC_DEP_CHECK                I SET_RESTRICTION               Set the rest(?) data                                        .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I CHECK_COMBINATION_CELL        Check and get valid pc/ppfctr,allocc/allocp combination     .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I CHECK_COMBINATION_LINE        check general combination level on line                     .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I CHECK_MODIFIABLE              Check if modifiable                                         .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I CHECK_NODEVALUE               Check a value is node or not                                .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I CHECK_SUBACC_INIT             Obsolete:Check if subassignment needs initial value         .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_BREAKDOWN                 Get single item's breakdown                                 .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_BREAKDOWN_SIMPLE          Get breakdown info                                          .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_CHARHRY                   Get hierarchy of char                                       .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_CHAR_SELCOND              Get selcond of single char from ffix/header/grid            .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_DEFVAL                    Get default value of subassignment                          .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_ITEMSIGN                  Get sign of single item                                     .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_ITEM_BKFLG                Get data entry posting block of item                        .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_REPUNIT_FIRSTENTRY        Get year and period of first entry of repunit               .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_SUPERORDINATE_SEL         Get selcond of master field                                 .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_TXTYPE_BKFLG              Get data entry posting block of txtype                      .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_TXTYPE_SIGN               Get sign of txtype                                          .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_UNIT                      Get unit(lckey/tckey/gckey/qukey) of single item            .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_VALUE_ALL                 Get all value of single char                                .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_VALUE_DESC                get single description of value when inserting new row      .
IF_UC_DEP_FUNCTION             I GET_VRS_NODEINPUT             Get node input attribute of versions                        .
IF_UC_DEP_HEADER               I CHANGE_HEADER                 Navigate header                                             .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I CHANGE_GRID                   Change grid value                                           .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I CHECK_HEADER                  Check current header and get info                           .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I CHECK_LINE                    Check a line and get information of this line               .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I CHECK_REASON_CELL             Get reason why a cell is closed                             .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I CHECK_TX_TO_DESEL             Check whether txdata matches selcond                        .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I GET_CELLRELATED               Get related gridcell                                        .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I GET_CONROWCOL                 Get conrowcol information                                   .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I GET_GRID                      Get grid information                                        .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I GET_GRIDHRY                   Get grid hry information                                    .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I GET_MESSAGE                   Get message from mapping                                    .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I INSERT_NEWLINE                Insert new lines                                            .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I MAP_GRID                      Mapping Grid Table                                          .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I MAP_HEADER                    Mapping header                                              .
IF_UC_DEP_MAPPING              I OPEN_LINE                     Open item's hrcy                                            .
IF_UC_DE_ACC_SCR_DATA          I GET_MESSAGE                   Get error messages                                          .
IF_UC_DE_ACC_SCR_DATA          I MOVE_CURSOR                   Move cursor to the specified position                       .
IF_UC_DE_ACC_SCR_DATA          I SUBMIT_NEW_ROWS               Get the data on account screen                              .
IF_UC_DE_DETAIL                I ADD_AFD_ENTRIES               Create Additional Financial Data Entries                    .
IF_UC_DE_DETAIL                I GET_AFD_ENTRIES               Read Additional Financial Data Entries                      .
IF_UC_DE_DETAIL                I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance of Method                                      .
IF_UC_DE_DETAIL                I REMOVE_AFD_ENTRIES            Delete Additional Financial Data Entries                    .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I ADD_NEW_LINE                  Add a new line in grid                                      .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I CHECK_DATA                    Check for save                                              .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I EC_HRY                        Expanded or collapsed hierarchy                             .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I GET_DATA                      Get dat(?) to display                                       .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I NAVIGATION_CHARS              Navigation characteristic's value                           .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I PUT_DATA                      Save Data                                                   .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I REFRESH_DATA                  Basic check                                                 .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I REQUEST_F1_HELP               F1                                                          .
IF_UC_DE_EVENT                 I REQUEST_F4_HELP               F4                                                          .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I CHECK                         Specific check                                              .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I GET_ALL                       Get all existed form                                        .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I GET_PROP                      Get form property                                           .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I GET_SELCOND                   Get selection condition of entire form                      .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I SET_NAME_OBJECT               Guid object -" Name object                                  .
IF_UC_DE_FORM                  I SET_PROP                      Set form property                                           .
IF_UC_DE_GRID                  I CHECK                         Specific check                                              .
IF_UC_DE_GRID                  I GET_PROP                      Get grid property                                           .
IF_UC_DE_GRID                  I GET_SELCOND                   Get selection condition                                     .
IF_UC_DE_GRID                  I SET_MODEL                     set model                                                   .
IF_UC_DE_GRID                  I SET_PROP                      Set grid property                                           .
IF_UC_DE_GRID_DATA             I DEP_GET_GRID                  Get the grid data                                           .
IF_UC_DE_HEADER                I CHECK                         Specific check                                              .
IF_UC_DE_HEADER_DATA           I DEP_GET_HEADERDATA            Get the header information                                  .
IF_UC_DE_HEADER_DATA           I DEP_GET_SELECTOR              Get the selector information via the selector id            .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I CHECK                         Specific check                                              .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I CHECK_ALL_OBJECT              Check all subobjects related                                .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I GET_FFIX                      Get ffix                                                    .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I GET_FORM_INSTANCE             Get form instances                                          .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I GET_PROP                      Get layout prop                                             .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I SET_MODEL                     Set model                                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LAYOUT                I SET_PROP                      Set layout prop                                             .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I ADD_LINE                      Add new lines                                               .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I ADD_LINE_VIA_POPUP            add new line via popup screen                               .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I CHANGE_CELLS                  Change cells in the logical form                            .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I EXPAND_ALL                    Expand the whole hierarchy                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I EXPAND_NODE                   Expand a hierarchy node by click on a line                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I F1_ON_GRID_CELL               F1 request on a grid cell                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I F1_ON_HEADER_ROW              F1 request on a header row                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I F4_ON_GRID_CELL               F4 request on a grid cell                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I F4_ON_HEADER_ROW              F4 request on a header row                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_FORM_ATTRIBUTES           Retrieve form attributes                                    .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_FORM_GRID                 Retrieve the grid table                                     .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_FORM_HEADER               Retrieve the header table                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_MODEL                     Get the model                                               .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_PREFERRED_CUSOR_POS       Get the preferred cursor position                           .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I GET_SUBACCNT_CANDIDATE        Get candidates for adding subaccount on the fly (on grid)   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I IS_INPUT_READY                Test whether the logical form allows user input             .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I IS_PREVIEW_MODE               Test whether the logical form is runing preview mode        .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I MOUSE_OVER_TEXT               to be added later(!)                                        .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I NAVIGATE_DIRECT_VALUE         Navigate grid by directly enter value in the header         .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I NAVIGATE_NEXT                 Navigation by click of the Next button                      .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I NAVIGATE_PREV                 Navigation by click on the Prev button                      .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I REFRESH_DISPLAY               Refresh the logical form(to be defined!)                    .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I REQUEST_TO_ADD_LINE           Request to add new line                                     .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I SET_INPUT_READY               Switch input readiness                                      .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM          I SET_PREVIEW_MODE              Set preview mode                                            .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I ADD_ROWS_FROM_POPUP           Add rows from popup to the logical form                     .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I ASSORT_ROW                    Sort the new rows to the layout and lock the new rows       .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I CHANGE_CELLS                  Change cells in the logical form                            .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I CHANGE_HEADER_VALUE           Navigate grid by directly enter value in the header         .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I CLEAR_ERROR_MESSAGE           Clear error message                                         .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I CLEAR_REFRESH_NEEDED          This method is called after refresh is done                 .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I COPY_ROW                      Request to add new line                                     .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I EXPAND_ALL                    Expand the whole hierarchy                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I EXPAND_NODE                   Expand a hierarchy node by click on a line                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I F1_ON_GRID_CELL               F1 request on a grid cell                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I F1_ON_HEADER_ROW              F1 request on a header row                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I F4_ON_GRID_CELL               F4 request on a grid cell                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I F4_ON_HEADER_ROW              F4 request on a header row                                  .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_ERROR_MESSAGE             Get error messages                                          .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_FORM_ATTRIBUTES           Retrieve form attributes                                    .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_FORM_GRID                 Retrieve the grid table                                     .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_FORM_GRID_PARTIAL_BY_CELL Get a part of the grid table                                .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_FORM_GRID_PARTIAL_BY_ROW  Get a part of the grid table                                .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_FORM_HEADER               Retrieve the header table                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_GRID_UPDATE               Retrieve the grid update table                              .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_HIGHLIGHT_ROWS            Get the new rows which should be highlighted                .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_MODEL                     Get the model                                               .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_MOUSE_OVER_TEXT           get mouse over text of a cell                               .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_PREFERRED_CURSOR_POS      Get the preferred cursor position                           .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_REASON_FOR_CELL           Get reason why a cell is locked                             .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_SUBACCNT_CANDIDATE        Get candidates for adding subaccount on the fly (on grid)   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I GET_VALUE_FILTER_F4           Filter fr bei F4 anzuzeigende Werte holen(for popup)        .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I IS_INPUT_READY                Test whether the logical form allows user input             .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I IS_PREVIEW_MODE               Test whether the logical form is runing preview mode        .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I IS_REFRESH_NEEDED             Check whether refresh of the display is needed              .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I IS_SAME                       Test whether a given logical form is same as this one       .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I NAVIGATE_NEXT                 Navigation by click of the Next button                      .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I NAVIGATE_PREV                 Navigation by click on the Prev button                      .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I REFRESH_DISPLAY               Refresh the logical form(to be defined!)                    .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I SET_DESCRIPTION               Set long text on/off                                        .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I SET_HEADER_DISPLAY            Set header display on/off                                   .
IF_UC_DE_LOGICAL_FORM2         I TRY_TO_SUBMIT_CHANGES         Try to submit the changed cells                             .
IF_UC_DE_PROCESSOR             I DEP_DISPATCH_EVENT            Dispatch the event from the frontend to dep                 .
IF_UC_DE_PROCESSOR             I DEP_GETWORKMODE               Get whether the processor is working in the previewmode     .
IF_UC_DE_PROCESSOR             I GET_DATA                      Get dat(?) to display                                       .
IF_UC_DE_PROCESSOR             I GET_FFIX                      Get fixed parameters                                        .
IF_UC_DE_QUERY                 I CALL_FRONTEND                 Get Frontend (BW Query runtime: BEX or WEB )                .
IF_UC_DE_QUERY                 I EXECUTE                       Execute (BCS backend)                                       .
IF_UC_DE_QUERY                 I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance for runtime representation                     .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I CANCEL                        CANCEL                                                      .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I FINISH                        Save                                                        .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I GET_ENVIOREMENT               Get the ffiix                                               .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I GET_MESSAGE                   Get the message from task                                   .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I GET_TREEHRYDATA               Get the hierarchy data of a tree                            .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I REGISTER_CHANGE               Register change                                             .
IF_UC_DT_OVERVIEW_DATA         I UNREGISTER_CHANGE             Unregister change                                           .
IF_UC_DYNAMIC_DOCUMENT_DATA    I CHECK_DATA                    Check your data                                             .
IF_UC_DYNAMIC_DOCUMENT_DATA    I GET_GUI_DATA                  Transfer Data from Data Object to Dynamic Document          .
IF_UC_DYNAMIC_DOCUMENT_DATA    I GET_MODEL                     Get Model Reference for F4 Help                             .
IF_UC_DYNAMIC_DOCUMENT_DATA    I SET_GUI_DATA                  Transfer Data from Dynamic Document to Data Object          .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_ACCOUNT_FACTORY           Get instance of a factory for target assignments            .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_APPLICATION_INSTANCE      Get instance for application                                .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_MINICUBE_FACTORY          Get instance of a factory for explicit values               .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_MODEL_FACTORY             Get instance of a model factory                             .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_SELCOND_FACTORY           Get instance of a factory for selection conditions          .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_SET_FACTORY               Get instance of a set factory                               .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_SINGLESELCOND_FACTORY     Get Instance of a Hierarchy Selection                       .
IF_UC_FACTORY                  I GET_VALCHECK_FACTORY          Get Instance of a Factory for Validation Checks             .
IF_UC_FACTORY_EXT              I COMMIT                        Commit a consistent state                                   .
IF_UC_FACTORY_EXT              I GET_LAYOUT_FACTORY            Get instance of a layout factory                            .
IF_UC_FACTORY_EXT              I GET_METHOD_FACTORY            Get instance of a method factory                            .
IF_UC_FACTORY_EXT              I ROLLBACK                      Rollback changes since last commit                          .
IF_UC_FACTORY_EXT              I SAVE                          Save all changes                                            .
IF_UC_FIELDLIST_FACTORY        I CREATE                        Create a Field List                                         .
IF_UC_FIELDLIST_FACTORY        I DELETE                        Delete a Field List                                         .
IF_UC_FIELDLIST_FACTORY        I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance of an Existing Field List                      .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I CREATE_UNION                  Create Union Field List                                     .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I IS_CONTAINING                 Is Transferred Field List Contained?                        .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I IS_CONTAINING_FIELD           Is field contained?                                         .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I IS_EQUAL                      Are Transferred Field Lists Identical?                      .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I IS_INITIAL                    Is Field List Initial?                                      .
IF_UC_FIELD_ABSTRACT           I IS_OVERLAPPING_WITH           Is there a non-empty overlap with the passed field length?  .
IF_UC_FIELD_ATTR               I IS_CONTAINING_FIELD           Is Transferred Field List Contained?                        .
IF_UC_FIELD_ATTR               I IS_EQUAL_FIELD                Are Transferred Field Lists Identical?                      .
IF_UC_FIELD_ATTR               I IS_INITIAL_FIELD              Is Field List Initial?                                      .
IF_UC_FIELD_ATTR               I IS_OVERLAPPING_WITH_FIELD     Is there a non-empty overlap with the passed field length?  .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_ITEM_PROVIDER  I LOAD_ITEMS                    Load Items on Demand                                        .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADD_COLUMN                    Add Column                                                  .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADD_ITEMS                     Add Items                                                   .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADD_KEY_STROKES               Keys that Trigger the KEYPRESS Event (except F1, F4 !)      .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADD_NODE                      Add Node                                                    .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADD_NODES                     Add Node                                                    .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ADJUST_COLUMN_WIDTH           Adapt Width of Columns to Their Contents                    .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I COLLAPSE_NODE                 Collapse Node                                               .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I COLUMN_GET_PROPERTIES         Properties of a Column (Without Width)                      .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I COLUMN_GET_WIDTH              Width of a Column                                           .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I CREATE_TREE_CONTROL           Instantiate Tree Control                                    .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I DELETE_ALL_NODES              Delete All Nodes                                            .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I DELETE_COLUMN                 Delete Column                                               .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Node                                                 .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I EXPAND_NODE                   Expand Node                                                 .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I EXPAND_NODE_SAFE              Expand Nodes; Number of Nodes -" Control Restricted         .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I FIND_ALL                      Find a String                                               .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I FREE_TREE_CONTROL             Reduce Tree Control                                         .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_COLUMN_ORDER              Column Sequence in Control                                  .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_EXPANDED_NODES            Gets Expanded Node from Control                             .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_FIRST_NODE                Returns First Root Node                                     .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_ITEM                      Returns a Cell / Item                                       .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_LEVEL_OF_NODE             Level of Node in Hierarchy (Root=0)                         .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_NODES_ITEMS_PROVIDED      All Nodes That Were Already supplied by ItemProvider        .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_NR_OF_COLUMNS             Number of Columns                                           .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_NR_OF_NODES               Number of Nodes                                             .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_NR_OF_ROOT_NODES          Number of Root Nodes                                        .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_PATH_TO_NODE              Determine Path to Nodes                                     .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_SELECTED_ITEM             Node Key and Item Name of the Selectetd Item                .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Selected Nodes                                              .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I HIERARCHY_HEADER_SET_TEXT     Set the Text of the Hierarchy Header                        .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I ITEM_SET_CHOSEN               Sets Checked State for a Checkbox                           .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I MOVE_NODE                     Moves Node in Tree                                          .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I NODE_GET_CHILDREN             Subordinate Node                                            .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I NODE_GET_PARENT               Parent Node of a Node                                       .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I PRINT_TREE                    Print Tree                                                  .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SCROLL                        Scrolls Tree Control                                        .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SELECT_ITEM                   Selects an Item                                             .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SELECT_NODES                  Select Nodes (Previously Selected Remain Selected)          .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_COLUMN_ORDER_FROZEN       Enable/Disable Column Rearrangement With the Mouse          .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_FILTER_OFF                Delete Filter on Nodes                                      .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_FILTER_ON                 Set Filter on Nodes                                         .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_ITEM_PROVIDER             Reload Items on Request                                     .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_REGISTERED_EVENTS         Register Events                                             .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_ROOT_NODE                 Set Root Node (For Focus)                                   .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I SET_TOP_NODE                  Sets Node That Appears at Top of Control                    .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I UNSELECT_ALL                  Remove All Selections                                       .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I UNSET_ROOT_NODE               Resets SET_ROOT_NODE (if Possible)                          .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I UPDATE_COLUMN                 Change Column                                               .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I UPDATE_ITEMS                  Change Items                                                .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I UPDATE_NODES                  Change Nodes                                                .
IF_UC_HIERARCHY_TREE           I WHICH_CONTROL                 Which Control Was Used?                                     .
IF_UC_HRY                      I ARE_CONNECTED                 Is there a path that links two nodes?                       .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_INHERITANCE_INSTANCE      Get Instance with Inheritance Info                          .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_LEAVES                    Get all end nodes                                           .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_NODES                     Get all nodes with given type                               .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_PARENTS                   Get all higher-level nodes                                  .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_SUB_ASSIGNMENTS           DO NOT USE !!!!!!!!!!!                                      .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time Stamp of Data Origin                                   .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TOP_NODE                  Get All Top Nodes                                           .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TREE                      Get Hy Info in Tree Format                                  .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TREE_INSTANCE             Make Instance for Tree Display                              .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TRUENODES                 Get All True Nodes                                          .
IF_UC_HRY                      I GET_TRUENODE_TYPE             Get All Real Node Types That Exist                          .
IF_UC_HRY_ADDKEY               I GET_ADDKEY                    Get Additional Key                                          .
IF_UC_HRY_INH_TI               I GET_HRY_INHERITANCE           Information About a Call-up Point                           .
IF_UC_HRY_INH_TI               I GET_RESTRICTION               Restriction to an Interval                                  .
IF_UC_HRY_TI                   I GET_HRY                       Get Hierarchy for a Time                                    .
IF_UC_HRY_TI                   I GET_INHERITANCE_INSTANCE      Get Instance with Inheritance Info                          .
IF_UC_HRY_TI                   I GET_RESTRICTION               Get Restriction to a Range                                  .
IF_UC_HRY_TI                   I GET_SUB_ASSIGNMENTS           DO NOT USE !!!!!!!!!!!                                      .
IF_UC_HRY_TI                   I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time Stamp of Data Origin                                   .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I CONVERT_CHKEY_TO_NID          Get set of NIDs for a char.value                            .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I CONVERT_NID_TO_SID            Get char.value SID for an NID                               .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I CONVERT_NID_TO_VALUE          Get char.value for an NID                                   .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I CONVERT_SID_TO_NID            Get set of NIDs for a char.value SID                        .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_ALL_CHILDREN              Get all (direct and indirect) lower-level nodes             .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_ALL_PARENTS               Get all (direct and indirect) higher-level nodes            .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_DIRECT_CHILDREN           Get all direct lower-level nodes                            .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_DIRECT_PARENT             Get all direct higher-level nodes                           .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_LEAVES                    Get all end nodes                                           .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_NEXT_DEEP_SEARCH          Next node in deep search                                    .
IF_UC_HRY_TREE                 I GET_TREE                      Get tree                                                    .
IF_UC_INOUT_CUST               I GET_CUST_TABLE                Get empty Customizing Table                                 .
IF_UC_INOUT_CUST               I READ_VALUE                    Output Customizing Settings                                 .
IF_UC_INOUT_CUST               I WRITE_VALUE                   Configure Customizing                                       .
IF_UC_INOUT_CUST_FACTORY       I GET_LIVING_INSTANCES          Get All Existing Instances                                  .
IF_UC_LAYOUT_STEP_CALLBACK     I CHECK                         Callback During Check                                       .
IF_UC_LAYOUT_STEP_CALLBACK     I GET_GUI_DATA                  Callback During Transfer of Data to GUI                     .
IF_UC_LAYOUT_STEP_CALLBACK     I GET_INITIAL_LAYOUT            Callback While Creating a Layout for Setting the Default    .
IF_UC_LAYOUT_STEP_CALLBACK     I SET_GUI_DATA                  Callback During Transfer of Data from GUI                   .
IF_UC_LOG_CUST_DATA            I CHECK_LOG                     Check Log                                                   .
IF_UC_LOG_CUST_DATA            I GET_DEFAULT_LOG_DEFINITION    Get Default Log Definition                                  .
IF_UC_LOG_CUST_DATA            I GET_DOC_LOG_ENTRY             "new by "jos130306 (SAP Note 929507)                        .
IF_UC_LOG_CUST_DATA            I GET_LOGTYPE_DEFINITION        Get Log Def. of Log Type                                    .
IF_UC_LOG_CUST_DATA            I MODIFY_DOC_LOG_ENTRY          Change Log Entry for Document                               .
IF_UC_LOG_GUI                  I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get GUI data                                                .
IF_UC_LOG_GUI                  I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_LOG_GUI                  I SET_GUI_DATA                  Rewrite Display-Related Data                                .
IF_UC_LP_CALLBACK              I CALLBACK                      Callback Method                                             .
IF_UC_LP_CALLBACK              I SET_STATUS                    Insert PF-STATUS                                            .
IF_UC_LP_VAL_DERIVATION        I GET_FIELD_VALUE               Get Derived Value                                           .
IF_UC_LP_WB_GUI_DATA           I GET_GUI_DATA                  Read GUI Data                                               .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I CREATE_MAPPING                Create a mapping                                            .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I CREATE_RULE                   Create an empty rule for a target field                     .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I DELETE_MAPPING                Delete a mapping                                            .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_INFO                      Get other information                                       .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_MAPPING                   Get a mapping                                               .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_MAPPINGID                 Get the mapping ID                                          .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_RULE                      Globally search for mapping rule with the rule ID           .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_RULE_BY_NAME              Globally search for mapping rule with name and cons.area    .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_RULE_BY_TARGETFIELD       Get the rule object of the mapping's target field           .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_RULE_LIST                 Get the mapping's rule list                                 .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I GET_RULE_NUMBER               Get the number of rules which are assigned to the mapping   .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I INVERSE_MAPPING               Reverse a mapping                                           .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I IS_EXECUTION                  If scenario is execution or customizing                     .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I SET_FIELDNAME                 Set the source and target fieldnames/factory(masterdata)    .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I SET_MODEL                     Set the source and target model                             .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I SET_SRC_TGT_FIELD             Set the source and target field list                        .
IF_UC_MAPPING                  I UNASSIGN_RULE                 Unassign a rule from the mapping                            .
IF_UC_MAPPING_EXECUTION        I INVERSE_MAPPING               Inverse mapping                                             .
IF_UC_MAPPING_EXECUTION        I MAPPING_DATA                  Mapping data                                                .
IF_UC_MAPPING_EXECUTION        I MAPPING_MASTERDATA            Mapping master data                                         .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_AREA                      Get its cons area                                           .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Calculate the description texts of the rule                 .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_LINE                      Get a line's content                                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_LINE_COUNT                Get the number of lines                                     .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_LINE_LIST                 Get the rule's lines                                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_LTXT                      Get the long text of the rule                               .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_MODEL                     Get the source and target model                             .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_NAME                      Get the name of the rule                                    .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_RULEID                    Get the rule ID                                             .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_SOURCE_FIELD_ATTR         Get the source fields of the rule                           .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_STATUS                    Calculate the status of the mapping rule: OK,WARNING,INVALID.
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I GET_TARGETFIELD               Get the target field                                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I INSERT_LINE                   Insert an operator(line) to the content                     .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I REMOVE_LINE                   Remove an operator(line) from the content                   .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I SET_LINE                      Set a line's content                                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I SET_LTXT                      Set the long text of the rule                               .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I SET_NAME                      Name or rename the rule                                     .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I SET_TARGETFIELD               Set the target field                                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE                  I UNNAME                        Unname the rule                                             .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I CREATE_OPERATOR               Create an operator instance                                 .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_APPLY                     Get the content of the APPLY operator                       .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_DESCRIPTION               Calculate the description texts of the operator             .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_IF                        Get the selection condition id if it's IF operator          .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_MOVE                      Get the content table of the MOVE operator                  .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_OPERATOR                  Get the operator represented by the object                  .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_REASSIGN                  Get the content table of the REASSIGN operator              .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I GET_STATUS                    Calculate the status of the operator                        .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I SET_APPLY                     Set the content of the APPLY operator                       .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I SET_IF                        Set the content of the IF operator                          .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I SET_MOVE                      Set the content table of the MOVE operator                  .
IF_UC_MAPRULE_OPR              I SET_REASSIGN                  Set the content of the REASSIGN operator                    .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ALL_CG_FOR_CG             All lower-level groups for the group                        .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ALL_CONS_AREAS            All cons areas                                              .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ALL_CU_FOR_CG             All units for a group and lower-level groups                .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ALL_DOCTY                 All document types with properties                          .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_CONS_FREQ_PROP            Cons frequency with period property                         .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ITEM_PROP                 Item Characteristics                                        .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_ITGRP_PROP                Breakdown categories with properties                        .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_NUMBER_OF_PERIODS         Number of Consolidation and Special Periods                 .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_OC_SEND_RECV_CUST         OC Customizing                                              .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_OC_TOP_NODES              OC Customizing                                              .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_PARENT_FOR_CG             Direct Higher-level Groups for Groups                       .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_SINGLE_DOCTY              Single document type with properties                        .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_TXTYPE_MASTER             Subitems with properties                                    .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_TXTYPE_PROP               Subitems with properties                                    .
IF_UC_MD_SERVICES              I GET_TXTYPE_TXT                Subitems with properties                                    .
IF_UC_METHOD_EXT               I EXECUTE                       Execute Method                                              .
IF_UC_METHOD_EXT               I EXECUTE_FINAL                 End Processing of Method Execution                          .
IF_UC_METHOD_EXT               I EXECUTE_INIT                  Initialization of Method Execution                          .
IF_UC_METHOD_EXT               I GET_LAYOUT                    Get Layout of Method                                        .
IF_UC_METHOD_EXT               I SET_LAYOUT                    Set Layout of a Method                                      .
IF_UC_METHOD_FACTORY           I GET_METHOD_CLASSNAME          Get Method Class                                            .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_EXT           I VALIDATE                      Validate transaction data                                   .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI           I GET_BW_AGGREGATE_FIELDS       Get Characteristics for a Proposed BW Aggregate             .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI           I GET_GUI_DATA                  Provide data                                                .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI           I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI           I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI_DATA      I GET_BW_AGGREGATE_FIELDS       Get Characteristics for a Proposed BW Aggregate             .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI_DATA      I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI_DATA      I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_GUI_DATA      I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_MSG_DATA      I GET_GUI_DATA                  Provide data                                                .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_MSG_DATA      I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_METHOD_VAL_MSG_DATA      I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_MINICUBE_GUI_DATA        I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_MINICUBE_GUI_DATA        I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_MINICUBE_GUI_DATA        I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CHECK_CHAR_AUTHORITY          Check Authorization                                         .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CHECK_CHAR_EXISTENCE          Check if char. values exist                                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CHECK_CHAR_VALIDITY           Check if Char. Values Are Valid                             .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CHECK_SINGLE_CHAR_EXISTENCE   Check if char. value exists                                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CHECK_SINGLE_CHAR_VALUE       Check a Characteristic Value: Existence, Validity, Combin.  .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONCATENATE_CHAR_VALUE        Convert Char. Value into Concatenated External Format       .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONVERT_CHAR_INPUT            Convert char.value to internal format                       .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONVERT_CHAR_OUTPUT           Convert char.value to external format                       .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONVERT_HRY_COMPOSITION       Conversion of Higher-level Fields f.Hierarchy Name/Text Node.
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONVERT_KFIG_INPUT            Convert Key Figure Value to Internal Format                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CONVERT_KFIG_OUTPUT           Convert Key Figure Value to External Format                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Create Data Reference                                       .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I CREATE_DERIVED_STRUCTURE      Derive Data Structure from Other Structure Information      .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I DERIVE_CONTEXT                Derive Context (Version, Time)                              .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_CHAR_FOR_UNIT             Get char. that determines currency key/unit of measure      .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_CHAR_HRY                  Get Instance of Hierarchy Structure                         .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_CHAR_HRY_ADDKEY           Get Additional Key for Hierarchy Identification             .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_CHAR_HRY_PROPERTIES       Get Hierarchy Properties of a Characteristic                .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_COMBINATION               Get Combination Object                                      .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I GET_REPUNIT_WITH_CHANGED_LCKEYGets Cons Units with Changed Local Currency                 .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I IS_INCLUDED_IN                Check whether Current Model Is Contained in Target Model    .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I MAP_TX_DATA_TABLE             Conversion Data Table between Application and CSE           .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I READ_CHAR_HRYNAME             List of Available Hierarchies for a Characteristic          .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I READ_CHAR_PROP                Determine Attributes for Given Characteristic Values        .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I READ_CHAR_VALUE               Get char values                                             .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I READ_SINGLE_CHAR_PROP         Determine Predefined Attributes                             .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I READ_SINGLE_CHAR_TEXT         Get texts for a char value                                  .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I REQUEST_CHAR_HELP             F1 help for char                                            .
IF_UC_MODEL                    I REQUEST_CHAR_VALUE            Possible entries for char                                   .
IF_UC_MULTICOMPOUND_GUI        I CREATE_COMPOUND               Create Compound (for new row in fast entry)                 .
IF_UC_MULTICOMPOUND_GUI        I DELETE_COMPOUND               Delete Compound (because row in fast entry is deleted)      .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I GET_EMPTY_PARAM               Get table with blank required parameters (initial logon)    .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I GET_MODEL                     Get model reference of global parameters                    .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I GET_PARAMETER                 Get parameters                                              .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I GET_PARAMETER_DB              Do not use!!!!                                              .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I REQUEST_PARAMETER             Send dialog box to prompt for parameters                    .
IF_UC_PARAMETER                I SET_PARAMETER                 Set global parameter without checking                       .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I GET_AREA                      Get active cons area                                        .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I GET_AREA_PARAM                Parameter for specific cons area                            .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I GET_AREA_TEXT                 Get description of cons area                                .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I GET_INCONSISTENCIES           Are parameters inconsistent?                                .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I GET_MESSAGES                  Get table with messages                                     .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I SAVE                          Save global parameters and current cons area                .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I SET_AREA                      Set active cons area or temporary cons area                 .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I SET_PARAMETER_TEMP            Set temporary parameters for temporary cons area            .
IF_UC_PARAMETER_REQUEST_GUI    I TEMP_2_ACTIVE                 Copy temp. tables in active settings                        .
IF_UC_PERIOD_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_UC_PERIOD_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_AUTHORIZED_VALUES         Values User is Authorized for                               .
IF_UC_PERIOD_AUTHORITY_CHECK   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_REPORTING_LOGIC          I APPLY                         Use Reporting Logic                                         .
IF_UC_REPORTING_LOGIC          I FINISH                        End Reporting Logic                                         .
IF_UC_REPORTING_LOGIC          I GET_RESTRICTION               Returns modified sel.cond. and field lists                  .
IF_UC_REPORTING_LOGIC          I INITIALIZE                    Prepare for Use of Reporting Logic                          .
IF_UC_REPUNIT_HRY_INHERITANCE  I INIT                          Initialize Instance                                         .
IF_UC_REPUNIT_HRY_INH_TI       I INIT                          Initialize Instance                                         .
IF_UC_SEL                      I CREATE_COPY                   Create copy of sel.cond. object                             .
IF_UC_SEL                      I CREATE_INTERSECTION           Determine intersection of two sel. conds                    .
IF_UC_SEL                      I CREATE_PARTIAL_SEL            Create a partial selection from the sel-cond object         .
IF_UC_SEL                      I CREATE_UNION                  Determine union of two sel. conds                           .
IF_UC_SEL                      I DEBUG                         Make instance transparent and break                         .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_CONTEXT                   Possibly Get Temporarily Set Context                        .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_FIELDS                    Get all contained fields and complexity per field           .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_SEL                       Only for Data Manager: Get table with sel.cond.             .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_SEL_PRINT                 Only for GUI: Get table with sel.cond. for output           .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_SINGLE_VALUE              Get the single value of the characteristic (if exists)      .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_SINGLE_VALUES             Get all characteristics with single values                  .
IF_UC_SEL                      I GET_VALUE_LIST                Return All Multi-Single Values                              .
IF_UC_SEL                      I INIT                          Initialize Instance                                         .
IF_UC_SEL                      I INIT_WITH_INTERSECTION        Initialize intersection of two selection conditions         .
IF_UC_SEL                      I INIT_WITH_UNION               Initialize union of two selection conditions                .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_CONTAINING                 Is the passed sel.cond. included?                           .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_CONTAINING_ACC             Is target assignment included?                              .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_CONTAINING_S_CHAR          Are the passed char values included?                        .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_CONTAINING_VALUE           Is the passed char.value included?                          .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_EQUAL                      Is the passed sel.cond. identical?                          .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_INITIAL                    Is the sel.cond. blank?                                     .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_OVERLAPPING_WITH           Overlap with (non-blank intersection)?                      .
IF_UC_SEL                      I IS_VOID                       Is Selection Condition Void?                                .
IF_UC_SEL                      I OVERWRITE_SEL_WITH            Replace fields of SelCond or add new ones                   .
IF_UC_SEL                      I REPLACE_CHAR                  Replace Fields of a Role by Fields of another Role          .
IF_UC_SEL                      I SET_CONTEXT                   Set Context (Temporarily!)                                  .
IF_UC_SEL                      I SET_SINGLE_VALUES             ATTENTION: METHOD STATUS PROPOSITIONAL                      .
IF_UC_SELACC                   I CHECK                         Check Customizing Object (incl. lower-level objects)        .
IF_UC_SELACC                   I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get GUI representation of data                              .
IF_UC_SELACC                   I SET_GUI_DATA                  Set data from GUI representation                            .
IF_UC_SELCOND                  I GET_SEL                       Get Instance of Matching Runtime Selection Object           .
IF_UC_SEL_CREATION             I GET_SEL                       Get Instance of Runtime Selection Object                    .
IF_UC_SEMANTICAL_KEY           I CONVERT_GUID_TO_SEMKEY        Convert GUID to a semantic key                              .
IF_UC_SEMANTICAL_KEY           I CONVERT_SEMKEY_TAB_TO_STRUC   Fill Semantic Key to Structure from Table                   .
IF_UC_SEMANTICAL_KEY           I CONVERT_SEMKEY_TO_GUID        Convert Semantic Key in GUID                                .
IF_UC_SET_GUI_DATA             I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_SET_GUI_DATA             I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_SET_GUI_DATA             I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_CHKEY_TO_SID          Get SID for a value key                                     .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_SID_TO_CHKEY          Get value key for an SID                                    .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_SID_TO_VALUE          Get value table for an SID                                  .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_TAB_CHKEY_TO_SID      Get SIDs for a set of value keys                            .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_TAB_MULTI_CHAR_TO_SID Convert char.value to SID                                   .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_TAB_MULTI_SID_TO_CHAR Convert SID to char.value                                   .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_TAB_SID_TO_CHKEY      Get value key for a set of SIDs                             .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I CONVERT_VALUE_TO_SID          Get SID for a value table                                   .
IF_UC_SIDMAP                   I GET_MAPTAB_CHKEY_SID          do not use !!!!                                             .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_CCTR       I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Singleselcond Data (for Concentrator)                   .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_CCTR       I SET_GUI_DATA                  Write Singleselcond Data (from Concentrator)                .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI        I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI        I GET_HRY                       Get Hierarchy                                               .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI        I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI        I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_DATA   I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_DATA   I GET_HRY                       Get Hry                                                     .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_DATA   I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_DATA   I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_FLAG   I HIDE_NAME_DESCRIP             Hide the name and description fields                        .
IF_UC_SINGLESELCOND_GUI_FLAG   I SHOW_NAME_DESCRIP             Show the name and description fields                        .
IF_UC_SISELCOND_GUI_DATA2      I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get Data                                                    .
IF_UC_SISELCOND_GUI_DATA2      I GET_HRY                       Get Hry                                                     .
IF_UC_SISELCOND_GUI_DATA2      I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_SISELCOND_GUI_DATA2      I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_STATUS_CHECK             I AUTHORITY_CHECK_TAB           Authorization Check - Table                                 .
IF_UC_STATUS_CHECK             I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Get Data Reference                                          .
IF_UC_STATUS_CHECK             I GET_TESTRUN                   Test run?                                                   .
IF_UC_STATUS_CHECK             I STATUS_CHECK                  Check Status - Structure                                    .
IF_UC_STATUS_CHECK             I STATUS_CHECK_TAB              Check Status - Table                                        .
IF_UC_STATUS_MANAGEMENT_PAIR   I CHECK_DONE                    Check if two sides are processed                            .
IF_UC_STATUS_MANAGEMENT_PAIR   I GET_CG_AFFECTED               Get groups involved                                         .
IF_UC_STATUS_MANAGEMENT_PAIR   I GET_CG_DONE                   Get groups processed                                        .
IF_UC_STATUS_MANAGEMENT_PAIR   I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance of two-sided status check                      .
IF_UC_STATUS_MANAGEMENT_PAIR   I UPDATE_CG_DONE                Get groups processed                                        .
IF_UC_STEP_HIERARCHY_GUI       I CREATE_CHILD                  Create lower-level step for a step                          .
IF_UC_STEP_HIERARCHY_GUI       I DELETE_STEP                   Delete a step                                               .
IF_UC_STEP_HIERARCHY_GUI       I IS_CHILD_POSSIBLE             Can a lower-level step be created?                          .
IF_UC_STEP_HIERARCHY_GUI       I UPDATE_SEQUENCE               Update Sequence of Steps Directly Beneath                   .
IF_UC_TASK                     I BUILD_USER_SELECTION          Complete User Selection Condition                           .
IF_UC_TASK                     I EXECUTE                       Execute Task                                                .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_GET_DATASTREAMTYPE       Determine Data Stream Types                                 .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_GET_DOCTYPE              Determine Assigned Document Type(s)                         .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_GET_PLEVEL               Determine Posting Level(s) of Task                          .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_GET_TASKPROC             Determine Processing Type (Unit, Pair, Group)               .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_GET_TASK_INFO            Determine Infos of Task                                     .
IF_UC_TASK                     I TASK_IS_INTERACTIVE           Interaction During Task Execution?                          .
IF_UC_TASK_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check                                         .
IF_UC_TASK_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I GET_AUTHORIZED_VALUES         Values User is Authorized for                               .
IF_UC_TASK_AUTHORITY_CHECK     I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_DEQUEUE                   Unblock (all blocks set up to now)                          .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_ENQUEUE                   Block (Paras: CU Combinations Opt.; Selection Condition)    .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_ENQUEUE_TAB               Block (Paras: Table with Filled Status-bearing Fields)      .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_EXECUTE                   Execute a Part of the Data Transfer Method                  .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_EXECUTE_ABORT             Terminate the Data Transfer Method                          .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_EXECUTE_ABORT_COMPLETE    Terminate the Data Transfer Method via Overview Screen      .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_EXECUTE_FINISH            End the Data Transfer Method (Status Update; Save)          .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_EXECUTE_FINISH_COMPLETE   End the Data Transfer Method via Overview Screen            .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_IS_LORIG                  Test Run of Data Transfer Method with Original List         .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_IS_TESTRUN                Test Run of Data Transfer Method                            .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_READ                      Read Transaction Data                                       .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_DTX       I DTX_REFRESH_MONITOR           Refresh Monitor Display                                     .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_EXT       I GET_INSTANCE                  Get instance of a task execution object                     .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_EXT       I INIT_INSTANCE                 Initializing Instance                                       .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I AUTHORITY_CHECK_1TASK         Authorization Check for a Task                              .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I AUTHORITY_CHECK_TAB           Authorization Check                                         .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I DEQUEUE_TAB                   Unlock Transaction Data                                     .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I ENQUEUE_TAB                   Lock Transaction Data                                       .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I GET_TX_DATA_CHANGE_FOR_DOCTYPEGet Data Change Object for a Document Type                  .
IF_UC_TASK_EXECUTION_SERVICES  I STATUS_CHECK_TAB              Status Query                                                .
IF_UC_TASK_EXEC_EXT            I EXECUTE                       Execute Task                                                .
IF_UC_TASK_EXEC_EXT            I EXECUTE_FINAL                 End Processing of Task Execution                            .
IF_UC_TASK_EXEC_EXT            I EXECUTE_INIT                  Initialization of Task Execution                            .
IF_UC_TASK_EXEC_EXT            I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADD_COLUMN                    Add Column                                                  .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADD_ITEMS                     Add Items                                                   .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADD_KEY_STROKES               Define Keys that Trigger KEYPRESS Events                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADD_NODE                      Add Node                                                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADD_NODES                     Add Node                                                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ADJUST_COLUMN_WIDTH           Adapt Width of Columns to Their Contents                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I COLLAPSE_NODE                 Collapse Node                                               .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I COLUMN_GET_PROPERTIES         Properties of a Column (Without Width)                      .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I COLUMN_GET_WIDTH              Width of a Column                                           .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I CREATE_TREE_CONTROL           Instantiate Tree Control                                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I DELETE_ALL_NODES              Delete All Nodes                                            .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I DELETE_COLUMN                 Delete Column                                               .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I DELETE_NODE                   Delete Node                                                 .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I EXPAND_NODE                   Expand Node                                                 .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I EXPAND_NODE_SAFE              Expand Nodes; Number of Nodes -" Control Restricted         .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I FIND_ALL                      Find a String                                               .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I FREE_TREE_CONTROL             Reduce Tree Control                                         .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_COLUMN_ORDER              Column Sequence in Control                                  .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_EXPANDED_NODES            Gets Expanded Node from Control                             .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_ITEM                      Returns a Cell / Item                                       .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_NR_OF_COLUMNS             Number of Columns                                           .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_SELECTED_ITEM             Node Key and Item Name of the Selectetd Item                .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I GET_SELECTED_NODES            Selected Nodes                                              .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I HIERARCHY_HEADER_SET_TEXT     Set the Text of the Hierarchy Header                        .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I ITEM_SET_CHOSEN               Sets Checked State for a Checkbox                           .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I MOVE_NODE                     Moves Node in Tree                                          .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I PRINT_TREE                    Print Tree                                                  .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SCROLL                        Scrolls Tree Control                                        .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SELECT_ITEM                   Selects an Item                                             .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SELECT_NODES                  Select nodes                                                .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SET_COLUMN_ORDER_FROZEN       Enable/Disable Column Rearrangement With the Mouse          .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SET_ITEM_PROVIDER             Load Items on Demand                                        .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SET_REGISTERED_EVENTS         Register Events                                             .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SET_ROOT_NODE                 Set Root Node (For Focus)                                   .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I SET_TOP_NODE                  Sets Node That Appears at Top of Control                    .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I UNSELECT_ALL                  Remove All Selections                                       .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I UNSET_ROOT_NODE               Resets SET_ROOT_NODE (if Possible)                          .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I UPDATE_COLUMN                 Change Column                                               .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I UPDATE_ITEMS                  Change Items                                                .
IF_UC_TREE_GUI                 I UPDATE_NODES                  Change Nodes                                                .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I ADD                           Add data of another object to the object                    .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I INIT                          Re-initialize Object                                        .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I INVERT                        Invert Data of Object                                       .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I READ                          Read data from I/O path to object                           .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I REFRESH                       Delete All Data of Object                                   .
IF_UC_TX_DATA                  I SAVE                          Save data of object to I/O path, absolute                   .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_BUFFER           I COMMIT                        Write data to data stream                                   .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_BUFFER           I POST                          tbd: write data to buffer                                   .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_BUFFER           I POST_DELTA                    tbd: write changes to buffer                                .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_BUFFER           I READ                          tbd: read data from buffer                                  .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_BUFFER           I SAVE                          Write buffer to BW! Commit is a prerequisite!               .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_CHANGE           I ADD_AND_REFRESH               Transfer Data from another Object and then Delete this      .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_CHANGE           I ANALYZE_AND_ADD_DATA          Check and Normalize; If OK, Add Data                        .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_CHANGE           I ANALYZE_AND_NORMALIZE         Check and Normalize                                         .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_INT              I POST_DELTA_INT                tbd: write change to data stream                            .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_INT              I POST_INT                      tbd: write data to data stream                              .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_INT              I READ_INT                      tbd: read data from data stream                             .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_IO               I ADD_DATA                      Write data (additively) to data object/stream/buffer        .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_IO               I DELETE_DATA                   Delete Data in Stream!                                      .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_IO               I GET_DATA                      Read data from data object/stream/buffer                    .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_IO               I IS_AFD_RELEVANT_DSTYPE        Writes in AFD-ODS?                                          .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_IO               I REPLACE_SEL_FOR_AFD           Swaps Version in Selectio Condition for AFD                 .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_STREAM           I CLOSE_CURSOR                  Close Cursor                                                .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_STREAM           I FETCH_DATA                    Read Data Package from Data Object/Stream/Buffer            .
IF_UC_TX_DATA_STREAM           I OPEN_CURSOR                   Open Cursor                                                 .
IF_UC_UPL_READER_VISITOR       I DERIVE_FIELD_VALUE            Derive field value in data structure.                       .
IF_UC_VALCHECK                 I CLEAR_BUFFERS                 Throw out buffer                                            .
IF_UC_VALCHECK                 I GET_FIELDLIST                 Get Group-by Fieldlist                                      .
IF_UC_VALCHECK                 I GET_FOEV                      Get formula during evaluation                               .
IF_UC_VALCHECK                 I GET_SELECTIONS                Get Selection Conditions                                    .
IF_UC_VALCHECK                 I GET_TEXTS                     Get Texts                                                   .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I COPY_SELCOND                  Copy Selection Conditions                                   .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I CREATE_SELCOND                Create selection condition                                  .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I DELETE_SELCOND                Delete Selection Condition                                  .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I FIELDLIST_EMPTY               Is Field List Empty?                                        .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I GET_FIELDLIST                 Get field list (create if necessary)                        .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I GET_GUI_DATA                  Provide data                                                .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I GET_SELCOND                   Make selection condition available                          .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_VALCHECK_GUI_DATA        I VALCHECK_EMPTY                Is validation check empty?                                  .
IF_UC_VAL_FOBU_CONNECTOR       I PUSHBUTTON_OP_SET             Set operand for button                                      .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I COPY_VALUE                    Copy value                                                  .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I CREATE_VALUE                  Create value                                                .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete Value                                                .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I GET_DATA                      Provide data                                                .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I GET_VALUE                     Provide value                                               .
IF_UC_VAL_HIERARCHY_GUI        I SET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_VAL_MSGV_EVALUATION      I EVALUATE_VARIABLE             Evaluation of a messsage variable                           .
IF_UC_VAL_MSG_GUI_DATA         I GET_GUI_DATA                  Provide data                                                .
IF_UC_VAL_MSG_GUI_DATA         I GET_MODEL                     Get Model                                                   .
IF_UC_VAL_MSG_GUI_DATA         I SET_GUI_DATA                  Return Data                                                 .
IF_UC_VAL_SERVICES             I GET_COMPOUND_TO_SELCOND       Get instance for compound                                   .
IF_UC_VAL_TREE_GUI_DATA        I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get data from data object                                   .
IF_UC_VAL_TREE_GUI_DATA        I SET_GUI_DATA                  Rewrite data                                                .
IF_UC_WB_LP_GUI_DATA           I GET_GUI_DATA                  Read GUI Data                                               .
IF_UDDICLIENT_PUBLISH          I GET_AUTHCHECK_OBJECT          Get Object for Authorization Check                          .
IF_UDDICLIENT_PUBLISH          I GET_BINDING_DESCRIPTION       Fill Data for UDDI Registration of Bindings                 .
IF_UDDICLIENT_PUBLISH          I GET_SERVICE_DESCRIPTION       Fill Data for the UDDI Regsitration of Services             .
IF_UDDICLIENT_PUBLISH          I GET_TMODEL_DESCRIPTION        Fill Data for the UDDI Registration of tModels              .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_AMOUNT_TO_BE_COLLECTED    Calculate Amount to Be Collected                            .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_ARRANGED_AMOUNT           Amount Assigned                                             .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_BROKEN_AMOUNT             Amount Promised but Not Paid                                .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_COLL_ITEMS                Read Open Items                                             .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_CREDIT_AMOUNT             Calculate Credit Amount                                     .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_CREDIT_COMMITS            Table of Credit Exposure Indicators                         .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_CREDIT_EXPOSURE           Credit Limit Utilization                                    .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DEBIT_AMOUNT              Calculate Debit Amount                                      .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DISPUTED_AMOUNT           Disputed Amount                                             .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DISPUTED_ITEMS            Open Items with Dispute Case                                .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DISPUTE_CASES             Read Dispute Cases                                          .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DUE_AMOUNT                Calculate Amount Due                                        .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DUE_AMOUNTS_BY_PERIOD     Total Amounts Due in the Future                             .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_DUNNED_ITEMS              Dunned Open Items                                           .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_KEY_FIGURES               Determine FI Key Figures                                    .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_LAST_CCT                  Read Last Customer Contact                                  .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_LAST_CCT_DATE             Date of Last Customer Contact                               .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_LAST_PAYMENT              Read Last Payment                                           .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_OPEN_RESUBMISSIONS        Read Open Submissions                                       .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_OVERDUE_AMOUNT            Calculate Overdue Amount                                    .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_OVERDUE_AMOUNTS_BY_PERIOD Overdue Total Amounts                                       .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_P2PS                      Read Promises to Pay                                        .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_PAYMENTS                  Read Payments                                               .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_RISK_CLASS                Risk Class                                                  .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_TOTAL_AMOUNT              Calculate Total Amount                                      .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_TOTAL_DUNNED_AMOUNT       Amount Dunned                                               .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I GET_TOTAL_PROMISED_AMOUNT     Amount Promised                                             .
IF_UDM_BUPA_TRANSACTION_DATA   I IS_DIRECT_PAYER               Business Partner Is Direct Payer                            .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I ADD_TEXT_ATTRIBUTE            Also Sets Text Attribute                                    .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I GET_CASE_ATTR_FROM_CUR_RESULT Delivers Attributes for Case Found                          .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I GET_CHANGEABLE_ATTR           Modifiable Attributes                                       .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I GET_MASS_ACTIVITIES           Provides Possible Mass Activities                           .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I GET_PREDEFINED_SELECTS        Predefined Searches                                         .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I INITIALIZE                    Start Search                                                .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR            I PREDEFINED_SEARCH             Execute Predefined Search                                   .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR_API        I FIND_CASES                    Find Dispute Cases                                          .
IF_UDM_CASE_LOCATOR_API        I GET_LOCATOR                   Specifies instance of a Locator object                      .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_INVOICE      I GET_ALL_P2P_CASES             Read all promises to pay created for invoice                .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_INVOICE      I GET_AMOUNT_TO_BE_COLLECTED    Calculate Amount to Be Collected                            .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_INVOICE      I GET_BROKEN_AMOUNT             Broken amount                                               .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_INVOICE      I GET_OPEN_ITEMS                Read Open Items for Invoice                                 .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_INVOICE      I GET_P2P_CASE                  Read current promise to pay                                 .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_ITEM         I GET_DISPUTE_CASE              Read Dispute Case                                           .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_ITEM         I GET_DUE_DATE_BY_STRATEGY      Due Date According to Strategy                              .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_ITEM         I GET_INVOICE                   Read Invoice                                                .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_ITEM         I GET_OPEN_AMOUNT_BY_STRATEGY   Amount Due According to Strategy                            .
IF_UDM_COLLECTION_ITEM         I READY_TO_BE_COLLECTED         Can amount be collected?                                    .
IF_UDM_COLL_AMT_C              I CALC_AMOUNT_TO_BE_COLLECTED   Calculate Amount to Be Collected                            .
IF_UDM_DISPUTE_CASE_ATTR       I GET_CASE_ATTR                 Read Case Attributes                                        .
IF_UDM_DISPUTE_CASE_ATTR       I GET_COLLECTION_ITEMS          Open Items for Dispute Case                                 .
IF_UDM_DISPUTE_CASE_ATTR       I GET_DM_CASE_ATTR              Read Dispute Case Attribute                                 .
IF_UDM_DISPUTE_CASE_ATTR       I READY_TO_BE_COLLECTED         Is dispute case to be collected?                            .
IF_UDM_MASS_ACTIVITY           I EXECUTE                       Execute Mass Activity                                       .
IF_UDM_MSG_HANDLER             I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds a Message (Based on the System Fields)                 .
IF_UDM_MSG_HANDLER             I ADD_SY_MESSAGE                Adds a Message (Based on the System Fields)                 .
IF_UDM_MSG_HANDLER             I CLEAR                         Deletes All Messages Collected from the Message Handler     .
IF_UDM_MSG_HANDLER             I DISPLAY                       Displays the Collected Messages                             .
IF_UDM_MSG_HANDLER             I GET_MESSAGE_COUNT             Supplies the Number of Collected Messages                   .
IF_UDM_P2P_CASE_ATTR           I GET_CASE_ATTR                 Read Case Attributes                                        .
IF_UDM_P2P_CASE_ATTR           I GET_INVOICE                   Invoice for Promise to Pay                                  .
IF_UDM_P2P_CASE_ATTR           I GET_P2P_CASE_ATTR             Read Attributes of Promise to Pay                           .
IF_UDM_P2P_CASE_ATTR           I IS_BROKEN                     Is promise to pay broken?                                   .
IF_UDM_P2P_CASE_ATTR           I IS_OPEN                       Is promise to pay open?                                     .
IF_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN            I GET_SELECT_OPTIONS            Read Selection Options                                      .
IF_UDM_PARALLEL_RUN            I STOP_RUN                      Stop All Batch Processes                                    .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I ACTIVATE                      Activates All Processed Aggregation Levels                  .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I CHANGE                        Changes Aggregation Levels                                  .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I CREATE                        Generates Aggregation Level                                 .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I EXISTENCE_CHECK               Returns, Whether Aggregation Level Exists                   .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I GET_DETAIL                    Supplies Detailed Info on Aggregation Level                 .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I GET_LIST                      Supplies a List of Aggregation Levels                       .
IF_UG_BW_AGGREGATION_LEVEL     I SAVE                          Saves all Processed Aggregation Levels after CHANGE         .
IF_UG_BW_COMMENT               I SHOW                          Display Comments/Documentation                              .
IF_UG_BW_CUBE                  I CHANGE                        Creates an InfoProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_CUBE                  I CREATE                        Creates an InfoProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_CUBE                  I DISPLAY                       Display an Infocube                                         .
IF_UG_BW_CUBE                  I GET_DETAIL                    Reads Detail Information on an Infocube                     .
IF_UG_BW_CUBE                  I GET_LIST                      Gets a List of Infocubes                                    .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I ACTIVATE_HRY                  Activates exactly one hierarchy                             .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I CHECK_AGGR_FOR_HRY            Does hierarchy have aggregates?                             .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I DELETE_HRY_STRUCTURE          Deletes Hierachy Structure                                  .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I GET_HRY_CATALOG               Get HY Catalog                                              .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I GET_HRY_STRUCTURE             Get HY Structure                                            .
IF_UG_BW_HRY                   I UPDATE_HRY_STRUCTURE          Updates Hierachy Structure                                  .
IF_UG_BW_IOBC                  I GET_DETAIL                    Get Details of an InfoObjectCatalog                         .
IF_UG_BW_IOBC                  I GET_LIST                      Get List of InfoObjectCatalogs                              .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CHA_VALUES_GET                List of Characteristic Values                               .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CHECK_AUTH_ADMWB_MD           Authorization Protection Master Data Maintenance (from BW30).
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CHECK_AUTH_CHAR               Authorization Check for Characteristic Value (from BW30)    .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CH_AT_TIME_GET                Read Values of Time-Dependent Attributes                    .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CH_TX_TIME_GET                Read Values of Time-Dependent Attributes                    .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CONVERT_INPUT                 Convert Characteristic Value into Internal Format           .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I CONVERT_OUTPUT                Convert Characteristic Value into External Format           .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I DISPLAY                       Display the infoobject                                      .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I GET_DETAIL                    Get Details About an InfoObject                             .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I GET_FIELDNM_IN_DDIC           Gets Field Names for IObj or Nav.Attr. in DDIC              .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I GET_LIST                      Get list of info objects                                    .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I GET_TIMESTMP                  Get time stamp for list of info objects (BW 3.0 and Later)  .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I MD_ATTRIBUTES_ACTIVATE        Activate Master Data Attributes                             .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I MD_ATTRIBUTES_UPDATE          Update Master Data Attributes                               .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I MD_DELETE                     Deleting Master Data                                        .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I MD_DELETE_SIMULATION          Simulation of Deleting Master Data                          .
IF_UG_BW_IOBJ                  I MD_TXT_UPDATE                 Update Texts                                                .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I CONVERT_FIELDNAME_TO_BWFNAME  Convert Local Field Name to BW Field Name                   .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I CONVERT_FIELDNAME_TO_IOBJ     Converts Field Name to the Name of the InfoObject           .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I CONVERT_FIELDNAME_TO_NAV_ATTR Break Down Local Field Name for Navigation Attribute        .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I CONVERT_IOBJ_TO_FIELDNAME     Converts the Name of the InfoObject to Field Name           .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I GET_RFCDEST_TO_IOBJ           Query RFC Destinations of an InfoObject                     .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I REGISTER_INFO_OBJECT          Register InfoObject for Usage                               .
IF_UG_BW_MAPPING_SERVICES      I REGISTER_NAV_ATTR             Register Navigation Attribute for Usage                     .
IF_UG_BW_MPRO                  I CHANGE                        Creates a MultiProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_MPRO                  I CREATE                        Creates a MultiProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_MPRO                  I GET_DETAIL                    Reads Detail Information About a MultiProvider              .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I CHANGE                        Creates an InfoProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I CREATE                        Creates an InfoProvider                                     .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I DISPLAY                       Display an ODS                                              .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I EXISTS_DATA                   Check if data exits                                         .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I GET_DETAIL                    Reads Detail Information on an Infocube                     .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I GET_LIST                      Gets a List of Infocubes                                    .
IF_UG_BW_ODS                   I GET_TIMESTMP                  Gets time stamp for list of ODS objects (from BW 3.0)       .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I ARRAY_DELETE_DATA             Delete Array of Records from a T-ODS                        .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Creates FINBASIS data structure for transaction data        .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I DELETE_DATA                   Delete Records from a T-ODS with Selection Condition        .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I INSERT_DATA                   Write New Records to Transactional ODS                      .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I MODIFY_DATA                   Write New Records to Transactional ODS                      .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I READ_DATA_FROM_INFOPROV       Read Transaction Data from InfoProvider                     .
IF_UG_BW_ODS_DATA              I UPDATE_DATA                   Update Records in Transactional ODS                         .
IF_UG_BW_QUERY                 I GET_LIST                      Provides a List of all Queries per Infoprovider             .
IF_UG_BW_QUERY                 I GET_VARIABLES                 Provides all variables used in a query                      .
IF_UG_BW_QUERY                 I START_DESIGN_TIME             Start of Query Designer                                     .
IF_UG_BW_QUERY                 I START_RUNTIME                 Start of BEX or WEB Query                                   .
IF_UG_BW_SERVICES              I CHECK_ALLOWED_CHAR            Checks if all characters are invariant                      .
IF_UG_BW_SERVICES              I CHECK_CHAVL                   Is char.value permitted?                                    .
IF_UG_BW_SERVICES              I GET_ALLOWED_CHAR              Permitted Characters in BW System                           .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I CONVERT_DATA_BW_2_SEM         Read Transaction Data from InfoProvider                     .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I CONVERT_HRY_DATA_SEM_2_BW     Read Transaction Data with Hy Node Selection                .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I READ_DATA_FROM_INFOPROV       Read Transaction Data from InfoProvider                     .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I READ_DATA_FROM_INFOPROV_HRY   Read Transaction Data with Hy Node Selection                .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I READ_DATA_FROM_INFOPROV_SID   Read Transaction Data with Hy Node Selection                .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA               I WRITE_DATA_INTO_INFOCUBE      Write Transaction Data to Transactional InfoCube            .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA_DEBUG         I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Check the Saved Data for Consistency                        .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA_DEBUG         I STORE_INFOCUBE                Save InfoCube Data for Later Check                          .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA_DEBUG         I STORE_ODS_ARRAY_DELETE        Save ODS Data for Later Check                               .
IF_UG_BW_TX_DATA_DEBUG         I STORE_ODS_MODIFY              Save ODS Data for Later Check                               .
IF_UG_MD_APPLICATION           I CHECK_EXISTANCE               Does the application already exist?                         .
IF_UG_MD_APPLICATION           I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_MD_APPLICATION           I GET_NOTIFICATION              Response to Messages                                        .
IF_UG_MD_APPLICATION           I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Properties                                             .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I COPY_CHAR_VALUE               Deep copy of characteristic value from CL_UG_MD classes     .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I COPY_SUB_OBJECT               Deep copy of the application dependent sub object           .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I DELETE_CHAR_VALUE             Deep delete of characteristic value from CL_UG_MD classes   .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I DELETE_SUB_OBJECT             Delete of the application dependent sub object              .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I GET_FIELD_SUB_OBJECT          Gets list of sub object for received fieldname              .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I GET_VALUE_SUB_OBJECT          Gets list of sub object for received characteristic value   .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_AFTER_PREPARE       Start of _PREPARE_FOR_UPDATE during after import            .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_AFTER_PROCESS       Start of _PROCESS_DATA during after import                  .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_BEFORE_ADD_TABLE    Possibility to add table names necessary during generation  .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_BEFORE_END          End of METADATA processing during before export             .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_BEFORE_START        Start of METADATA processing during before export           .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_SUBOBJ           I TRANSPORT_PREPARE             Called during transport create                              .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I EXCLUDE_DIRECT_USAGE          Gets Fields That Are Not Searched for Direct Usage          .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I GET_FIELDNAMES                Get field names for which reading must take place           .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I GET_WU_MD_INSTANCE            Get instance of IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU                            .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I GUID_FIELD_OVERRIDE           GUID Field Name                                             .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I NAVIGATE_TO_USAGE             Navigation for a Use                                        .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU               I READ_VALUE                    Read Characteristic Values                                  .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU_TX            I GET_WU_TX_INSTANCE            get instance of IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU_TX                         .
IF_UG_MD_APPL_WU_TX            I RUN                           call app-spec. where-used list in trx. data                 .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I CHECK_SINGLE_FIELD            Check Individual Field (Such As Change Monitor)             .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I END_CHANGE_BLOCK              End of a Series of Changes                                  .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GENERATE                      Perform Generation If Necessary                             .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_AREA_PROPERTY             Read Area Properties                                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELDS_FOR_BASEFIELD      Obsolete -" Use get_field_usage!                            .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_ATTRIBUTES          Attributes / Fields of a Field                              .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_HIERARCHY_FIELDS    Fields That May Occur in a Hierarchy                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_LIST                List of Registered Fields                                   .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_ORIGIN              Origin of Field (Info Object, ODS, Local...)                .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_PROPERTY            Read Properties of a Field                                  .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_ROLE                Possible Roles, etc., of a Field                            .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_ROLLNAME            Data Element of a Field                                     .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_TABNAME             All Tables (Generated and Delivered) of a Field             .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_FIELD_USAGE               Registration-dependent Uses of a Field                      .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_GENERATION_STATUS         Is a generation necessary?                                  .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_LIST                      List of All Area IDs for this Client                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_OPTIONS                   Options                                                     .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_PROPERTY_TEXT             Get Texts/Names of Property Fields                          .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_REGISTERED_FIELD          List of Registered Fields with Roles                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_RFCDEST_TO_FIELDNAME      Read RFC Destination                                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Read Time Stamp                                             .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I IS_FIELD_REGISTERED           Is a field registered in this AREAID                        .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I SET_AREA_PROPERTY             Determine Area Properties                                   .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I SET_FIELD_PROPERTY            Write Properties of a Field                                 .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I SET_REGISTERED_FIELD          Register Fields                                             .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I SET_RFCDEST                   Set RFC Destination                                         .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I SET_TEMPORARY_FIELD           Create Temporary Field                                      .
IF_UG_MD_AREAID                I START_CHANGE_BLOCK            Start of a Series of Changes                                .
IF_UG_MD_BUFFER_FACTORY        I GET_CHAR_INSTANCE             Instancize Characteristic                                   .
IF_UG_MD_BUFFER_FACTORY        I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Attributes                                        .
IF_UG_MD_BW                    I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete chars/attributes according to key list               .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I CONVERT_FIELDNAME_TO_BWFNAME  Converts Local Field Name to BW Field Name                  .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I CONVERT_FIELDNAME_TO_IOBJ     Converts Field Name to the Name of the InfoObject           .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I CONVERT_IOBJ_TO_FIELDNAME     Converts the Name of the InfoObject to Field Name           .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I GET_RFCDEST_TO_IOBJ           Query RFC Destinations of an InfoObject                     .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I REGISTER_INFO_OBJECT          Register InfoObject for Usage                               .
IF_UG_MD_BW_SERVICES           I SET_PREFERRED_RFCDEST         Set preferred destination for read calls to BW              .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT           I GET_DOCUMENTATION             Documentation                                               .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT           I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT           I GET_SEMANTIC_DEFINITION       Properties of Semantics                                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT           I GET_TREE                      Get Tree                                                    .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT           I PROCESS_EVENT                 Process Event                                               .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I GET_APPLICATION_TEXT          Description of the application                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I GET_AREAID_STATUS             Status of Application Area                                  .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I GET_AREAID_TEXT               Description of Application Area                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I GET_DOCUMENTATION             Documentation                                               .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I IS_FIELDNAME_NEEDED           Does application area require FIELDNAME ?                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_APPL      I IS_REGISTERED                 Do I know an application area ?                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_DATA      I GET_MESSAGE                   Messages for the Node                                       .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_DATA      I GET_SEMANTIC                  Registered Properties                                       .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_DATA      I GET_TREE_CONTENT              Content of Tree                                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHANGE_MGMT_DATA      I PROCESS_EVENT                 Edit OK Code                                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK                         Check Characteristic Values                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Consistency Check                                           .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check for Existence                                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK_SINGLE_EXISTENCE        Check if single value exists                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK_SINGLE_VALIDITY         Check validity of single value                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CHECK_VALIDITY                Check validity of values                                    .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CONVERT_FISCTIME              Converts Output Period to Internal Period                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CONVERT_INPUT                 Input Conversion                                            .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CONVERT_OUTPUT                Output Conversion                                           .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I COUNT_VALUE                   Get number of characteristic values                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Get Data Reference                                          .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CREATE_DATA_REF_FOR_DEPGROUP  Get Data Reference                                          .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I CREATE_VALUE_INSTANCE         Create Instance for New Characteristic Value                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete Characteristic Values                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION      Metainformation for Attributes                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_DETERMINING_ATTRIBUTES    Attributes that Are Required to Create a Value              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Properties                                        .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_HIERARCHY                 List of Hierarchies                                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_HIERARCHY_INSTANCE        Instance of a Hierarchy                                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_NET_INSTANCE              Instance for Network Data                                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time Stamp (Last Data Change)                               .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I GET_VALUE_INSTANCE            Get Instance for a Characteristic Value                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I READ_SINGLE_VALUE             Read a Characteristic Value                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I READ_VALUE                    Read Characteristic Values                                  .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I READ_VALUE_PROP               Read More Characteristic Values                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I REQUEST_HELP                  F1 Help                                                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I REQUEST_VALUE                 F4 Help                                                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I WRITE_SINGLE_VALUE            Write a Characteristic Value                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR                  I WRITE_VALUE                   Write Characteristic Values                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_AUTHORITY        I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check Authorization                                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_AUTHORITY        I GET_PROPERTY                  Return authorization fields                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_ENQUEUE          I DEQUEUE                       Remove lock                                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_ENQUEUE          I ENQUEUE                       Set Lock                                                    .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_ENQUEUE          I GET_PROPERTY                  Return fields for enqueue                                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INT              I TRANSPORT_DELETE              Get transport info for deletion                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INT              I TRANSPORT_WRITE               Get transport info for write                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check for Existence                                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I CHECK_SINGLE_EXISTENCE        Check if single value exists                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I CHECK_SINGLE_VALIDITY         Check validity of single value                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I CHECK_VALIDITY                Check validity of values                                    .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I COMMIT                        Commit changes                                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I COUNT_VALUE                   Get number of characteristic values                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete Characteristic Values                                .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION      Metainformation for Attributes                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Properties                                        .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_HIERARCHY                 List of Hierarchies                                         .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_HIERARCHY_INSTANCE        Instance of a Hierarchy                                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_MODIFIED_VALUES           Changed Values                                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I GET_OR_CREATE_VALUE_INSTANCE  Determine or Create Value Instance                          .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I READ_SINGLE_VALUE             Read Characteristic Value                                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I READ_VALUE                    Read Characteristic Values                                  .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I READ_VALUE_PROP               Read Attributes Also                                        .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I ROLLBACK                      Undo changes since COMMIT                                   .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I SAVE                          Save to database                                            .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I SYNCH_TO_LOCAL                Copy Values from BW into Locale Storage                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I TRANSPORT_BY_SEL              Manual Transport                                            .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_INTERNAL         I WRITE_VALUE                   Write Characteristic Values                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE            I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete Values from Current Status                           .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE            I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE            I READ_VALUE                    Read Values from Current Status                             .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE            I RELOAD                        Reload Current Status from the Database                     .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE            I WRITE_VALUE                   Write Values in Current Status                              .
IF_UG_MD_CHAR_VALUE_FILTER     I REDUCE_LIST                   Reduce Entries in Value List                                .
IF_UG_MD_CM_OBJECT             I GET_ALL_PROPERTIES            Get values of all properties                                .
IF_UG_MD_CM_OBJECT             I GET_ALL_PROPERTY_NAMES        Get names of all properties                                 .
IF_UG_MD_CM_OBJECT             I GET_PROPERTY                  Read Properties                                             .
IF_UG_MD_CM_OBJECT             I SET_PROPERTY                  Set Property                                                .
IF_UG_MD_CM_PARTICIPANT        I CHECK_GENERATION_POSSIBLE     Is a generation possible?                                   .
IF_UG_MD_CM_PARTICIPANT        I GENERATE                      Adjust Data Model                                           .
IF_UG_MD_CM_PARTICIPANT        I GET_AFFECTED_OBJECTS          Search objects affected by changes                          .
IF_UG_MD_CM_PARTICIPANT        I GET_CHANGE_OBJECTS            Search changed objects                                      .
IF_UG_MD_CM_PARTI_FACTORY      I GET_PARTICIPANTS              Get Participants for CM                                     .
IF_UG_MD_DISPATCHER_FACTORY    I GET_CHAR_INSTANCE             Instancize Characteristic                                   .
IF_UG_MD_DISPATCHER_FACTORY    I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Attributes                                        .
IF_UG_MD_FACTORY               I GET_CHAR_INSTANCE             Instancize Characteristic                                   .
IF_UG_MD_FACTORY               I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Attributes                                        .
IF_UG_MD_FACTORY               I GET_SINGLE_FIELD_PROPERTIES   Get Field Properties of Less Certain Fields                 .
IF_UG_MD_FACTORY               I GET_STATE_INFO                Messages on State - e.g. Inconsistent Field Definitions     .
IF_UG_MD_FACTORY               I GET_WHERE_USED_INSTANCE       Instantiate Where-Used List                                 .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I CHECK_COMBI_ODSOBJECT         Check if ODS Can Be Assigned to Combi Field                 .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I CHECK_REMOTE_EXISTENCE        Test Existence (Active) of Fields in Remote Systems         .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I CREATE_VALUE_SID              Get new Value SID(s)                                        .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I FILTER_IRRELEVANT_RFCDEST     Delete the RFC Dest. in which the field does not exist      .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION      Metainformation for Attributes                              .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_ATTR_MAPPING              Read Mapping of Attribute Pairs Role - Remote               .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_BASE_FIELD                Basic Field (Combines from Registration, FPROP+UGMD2200)    .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_COMBIFIELDS_FOR_FIELD     Get Use of a Field in Combi Fields                          .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_COMBI_ODSOBJECT           Read ODS Object for a Combination Field                     .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_FIELD_ORIGIN              Origin of a Field (Local, InfoObject, ODS, ...)             .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_FIELD_USAGES_STATIC       Get All Uses for a List of Fields                           .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_FISCVARNT                 Get Leading Fiscal Year Variant for Time-Dependent Access   .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_FPROP                     Read Field Properties                                       .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_MD_TIMESTAMP              Time Stamp of the Last Change Master Data/Hierarchy         .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_RELATED_FIELD             Fix BaseField (UGMD2200). Obsolete -"GET_BASE_FIELD instead!.
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_REPTEXT                   Column Header Texts                                         .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_TIMESTAMP_STATIC          Get Most Recent Time Stamp for a Field List                 .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_VALIDITY_TYPE             Type of Validity Check (see const. IF_UG_MD_FACTORY)        .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I GET_WHERE_USED                Get Uses of Field (According to Generated State!)           .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I REGISTER_GLOBAL_CHANGE        Global Change to Field; Increase TIMESTAMP(/~_MAJOR)        .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I SET_ATTR_MAPPING              Set Mapping of Attribute Pairs Role - Remote                .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I SET_COMBI_ODSOBJECT           Assign an ODS Object to a Combo Field                       .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I SET_FISCVARNT                 Set Leading FY Variant for Time-dep. Accesses               .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I SET_REPTEXT                   Set Explicit Heading Text in Logon Language                 .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I SET_VALIDITY_TYPE             Type of Validity Check (see const. IF_UG_MD_FACTORY)        .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I UPDATE_ACTIVE_FPROP           Note the Active/Generated State                             .
IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME             I UPDATE_MD_TIMESTAMP           Update Change Time Stamp Master Data / Hierarchies          .
IF_UG_MD_FIELD_DESCRIPTION     I GET_FIELD_DESCRIPTION         Get Description of a Field                                  .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I ACTIVATE                      Activate Hierarchies                                        .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I DELETE_EDGE                   Delete Hierarchy Edges                                      .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I GET_LIST                      List of Existing Hierarchies                                .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I GET_SID_MAP                   Mapping SID -" Get Values                                   .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Deliver Last Change Time Stamp                              .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I READ_EDGE                     Read Hierarchy in Optimized Notation                        .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I SET_ACTIVATION_MODE           Switch Automatic Hierarchy Activation Off and On Again      .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY             I WRITE_EDGE                    Write Hierarchy Edges (Create and Change)                   .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INHERITANCE I CREATE_REFERENCE_INTERVAL     Output table for read_data_interval                         .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INHERITANCE I READ_EDGE_INHERITANCE         Read attr.values for explicit and implicit edges            .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INHERITANCE I READ_EDGE_INHERITANCE_HIST    Read attr.values within a range                             .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I ACTIVATE                      Activate Hierarchies                                        .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I CHECK                         Trial Check of Changed Edges (Delte Node Logic, etc.)       .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I COMMIT                        Commit changes                                              .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I DEQUEUE                       Remove Node Lock                                            .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I ENQUEUE                       Set Node Lock                                               .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION      Read properties of edge attributes                          .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I GET_CHANGED_EDGES             List of Changed Edges                                       .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I GET_DELTA_LEAF_EDGES          Read edges for delta nodes that match it_hier_struct        .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I GET_LIST                      Read List of Hierarchies                                    .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time Stamp of Last Change of Hierarchy                      .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I READ_EDGE                     Read Hierarchy with Optimum Notation                        .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I READ_STRUCT_HISTORY           Read History of Hierarchy Structure                         .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I READ_TEXTNODES                Read text nodes with texts in logon language                .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I ROLLBACK                      Discard Changes                                             .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I SAVE                          Save committed changes                                      .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I SET_ACTIVATION_MODE           Switch Automatic Hierarchy Activation Off and On Again      .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I TRANSPORT                     Transport of Changed Edges                                  .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I UNDO                          Discard Last Change                                         .
IF_UG_MD_HIERARCHY_INT         I UNDO_ALL                      Discard Changes                                             .
IF_UG_MD_HRYNAME_FACTORY       I CONVERT_HRYNAME_EXTERNAL      Derive hierarchy name externally (with compounding)         .
IF_UG_MD_HRYNAME_FACTORY       I GET_CARRYING_FIELDNAME        Gets char. that has the hierarchy names                     .
IF_UG_MD_INTERVAL_OVERLAP      I COMBINE_DATA                  Combine Data of Two Ranges                                  .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_HEADER_CONTENT            Get Header Content                                          .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_SCREEN_SETTINGS           Get properties of screen to be displayed                    .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Get buttons for display                                     .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_TOOLBAR_EVENTS            Get events for toolbar                                      .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_TREE_CONTENT              Get structure and content of tree                           .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_TREE_EVENT                Get events for the tree                                     .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I GET_TREE_TITLE                Get title of tree (for printing)                            .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I SET_TOOLBAR_HANDLERS          Sets Toolbar Event Handler Methods                          .
IF_UG_MD_LIST_TREE_GUI         I SET_TREE_HANDLERS             Sets Tree Event Handler Methods                             .
IF_UG_MD_MANUAL_TRANSPORT      I TRANSPORT_BY_SEL              Manual Transport                                            .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I CHECK_DEFINITION_CONSISTENCY  Check Consistency of InfoObject Definitions in All BWs Used .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I CONVERT_STRUCT_TO_ITFIELD     Convert Structure to Pairs (Fieldname, Value)               .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I CONVERT_STRUCT_TO_ITVAL       Convert Structure to Pairs (Fieldname, Value)               .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GEN_ALL_NEW                   Generate AREAID                                             .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GET_ATTRIBUTES_OF_FIELD       Which Attributes Belong to a Field                          .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GET_FIELD_LIST                List of characteristics                                     .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GET_FIELD_TABNAME             Tables (Generated and Delivered) of a Field                 .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GET_FIELD_TO_TABNAME          Find Field Name for a Generated Table                       .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I GET_UPDATELOG_SEQNR           Get Unique SEQNR for Update Log (Storages)                  .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I MD_IS_GENERATED               Is Dictionary Type Generated?                               .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA             I TRANSPORT_BY_SEL              Manual Transport                                            .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I END_CHANGE_BLOCK              End of a Series of Changes                                  .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GENERATE                      Regenerate DDIC Structures (Without Test of Gen. Status)    .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_AREA_PROPERTY             Read Area Properties                                        .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_CHAR_PROPERTY             Specific Properties of a Characteristic                     .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_CHAR_ROLE                 Role of a Characteristic                                    .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_COMBINATION_FIELD         Determine Pair Object                                       .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_FIELD_BASE_FIELD          Obsolete -" New: GET_FIELD_RELATED_FIELD                    .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_FIELD_HIERARCHY_FIELDS    Fields That May Occur in a Hierarchy                        .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_FIELD_LIST                List of characteristics                                     .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_FIELD_RELATED_FIELD       Related Field for Deep Transport, Deletion and so on        .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_GENERATION_STATUS         Is a generation necessary?                                  .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_REMOTE_FPROP              Read Field Properties of Remote Fields (with Read Buffer)   .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_ROLE                      Allocated Roles                                             .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_ROLE_PROPERTY             Determine Properties of a Role                              .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_ROLE_SUBOBJECTS           Dependent Objects for a Role for Copy/Delete/Transport      .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_ROLE_TEXT                 Get Name of a Role                                          .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I GET_TEMP_FIELD                Create Temporary Field                                      .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I IS_COMBINATION_FIELD          Determine Pair Object                                       .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I IS_NAV_ATTRIBUTE              Trigger Nav. Attribute                                      .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_AREA_PROPERTY             Set Area Properties                                         .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_AREA_RFCDEST              In which BWs is an AREA used?                               .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_CHAR_PROPERTY             Specific Properties of a Characteristic                     .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_FIELD_REPTEXT             Write Special Texts for Column Headers (REPTEXT)            .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_ROLE                      Allocate Role to a Characteristic                           .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I SET_TEMP_FIELD                Create Temporary Field                                      .
IF_UG_MD_META_DATA_EXT         I START_CHANGE_BLOCK            Beginning of a Series of Changes                            .
IF_UG_MD_NODE_USAGE            I GET_ATTR_USAGE                Which Edges or Hierarchies Use Edges Attribute?             .
IF_UG_MD_NODE_USAGE            I GET_NODE_USAGE                Which hierarchies use nodes as parent/child?                .
IF_UG_MD_NODE_USAGE            I READ_EDGE_HIST                Read History of Hierarchy Structure                         .
IF_UG_MD_PRINT                 I CREATE_DATA_REFERENCE         Generate Reference to Table for List Output                 .
IF_UG_MD_PRINT                 I PRINT_ALV                     Prepare Data for List Output with ALV                       .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_AUTOMATIC_ROLES           Automatically Registered Roles of an Application            .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_AVAILABLE_ROLE            Possible Roles of an Info Object                            .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_CLASS_TIMESTAMP           Provide Time Stamp for a Global ABAP Class                  .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_DEFAULT_ROLE              Default Role of an Info Object in the Application           .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_DELTA_LEAF_ROLES          Supply All Roles that Require the Delta End Node            .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_DETERMINING_ATTRIBUTES    Attributes Needed for Creation                              .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_FIELDNAME_PROPERTY        Determine Attributes of a Field                             .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_MAX_ROLE_TIMESTAMP        Time Stamp of Last Generation-Relevant Role Change          .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLES_OF_APPLICATION      All Roles of an Application                                 .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_APPLCLASS            Application Class for a Role                                .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_ATTRIBUTE_GUI_DEF    Settings for Maintenance of Attributes                      .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_DEFINITION           Attributes of a Role                                        .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_FIELDNAME            Determine Fixed Field of a Role                             .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_FIELDS               Attributes / Fields of a Role                               .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_GEN_STRUCT           Get the Gener.Template of a Role                            .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_INTERVAL             Interval Fields for the Role                                .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_PROPERTY             Attributes of a Role                                        .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_ROLLNAME             Data Elements of the Role                                   .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_SUB_OBJECTS          Subobjects for a Role                                       .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_TEXT                 Role Description                                            .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_ROLE_WHERE_USED           Role Assignment for Where-Used List                         .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_SPECIAL_AUTHORITY_FIELDS  Fields Prescribed for Role for Authority Check              .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_SPECIAL_ENQUEUE_FIELDS    Fields Prescribed for Role for Enqueue                      .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I GET_TABNAME_ROLE              Particular Role Due to Which a Table Was Generated          .
IF_UG_MD_ROLE_FACTORY          I SET_TEMP_ROLE_DEF             Create Temporary Field                                      .
IF_UG_MD_SID                   I GET_MASS_SID                  Get SIDs of Multiple Values All at Once                     .
IF_UG_MD_SID                   I GET_SID                       List with Mapping SID "-" Value for Mass Processing         .
IF_UG_MD_SID                   I GET_SID_MAPPING               Get enriched structure for SID map                          .
IF_UG_MD_SID                   I GET_SINGLE_SID                Get SID of one value                                        .
IF_UG_MD_SID                   I GET_VALUE_TO_SINGLE_SID       Get value of one SID                                        .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check for Existence                                         .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I CHECK_SINGLE_EXISTENCE        Check for Existence of Itemized Value                       .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I CHECK_SINGLE_VALIDITY         Validity Check of Itemized Value                            .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I CHECK_VALIDITY                Validity Check                                              .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I COUNT_VALUE                   Get number of characteristic values                         .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I DELETE_VALUE                  Delete Characteristics/Attributes as per Key List           .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_DEFINITION      OBSOLETE - use IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME instead                   .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          OBSOLETE - use IF_UG_MD_FIELDNAME instead                   .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I READ_SINGLE_VALUE             Read Characteristic Value with Attributes                   .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I READ_VALUE                    Determine Characteristic List with Attributes               .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I READ_VALUE_PROP               Read Attributes Also                                        .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I TRANSPORT_BY_SEL              Manual Transport                                            .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_CHAR          I WRITE_VALUE                   Write Characteristic List with Values                       .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I CONVERT                       Check/convert data (e.g. change of dependency of time/vers.).
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I DELETE_AND_WRITE_EDGE         Delete and write at the same time (to boost performance)    .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I GET_TIMESTAMP                 Time Stamp of Last Change of Hierarchy                      .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I READ_EDGE                     Read Hier. in Optimum Notation                              .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I READ_STRUCT_HISTORY           Read History of Hierarchy Structure                         .
IF_UG_MD_STORAGE_HIER          I READ_TEXTNODES                Read text nodes with texts in logon language                .
IF_UG_MD_SUB_OBJECT            I GET_CLASS_FOR_ROLE            Get list of registered classes for role                     .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I BUILD_CHAR_SEL_TAB            Criteria for Selecting All Fields Relevant for Sync         .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I GET_FIELD_PROPERTIES          Get Field Properties                                        .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I GET_GUI_DATA                  Get GUI data                                                .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I REGISTER_GUI_OBJECT           Announce GUI Object of Workbench                            .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I RESOLVE_DIFFERENCES           Resolve Differences                                         .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_CHAR_GUI_DATA   I SET_GUI_DATA                  Set GUI data                                                .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_HIER            I BUILD_HIER_SEL_TAB            Criteria for Selecting All Fields Relevant for Sync         .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_HIER            I GET_PARENTS                   Gets a list of parents for the child                        .
IF_UG_MD_SYNCH_HIER            I GET_SIDMAP                    Get current SID map                                         .
IF_UG_MD_VALUE_MAPPING         I CHECK_MAPPING                 Check Whether Mapping Can Be Dealt with by this Class       .
IF_UG_MD_VALUE_MAPPING         I CONVERT_SEL_TAB               Switch Attribute Selection to Remote Format                 .
IF_UG_MD_VALUE_MAPPING         I MAP_VALUE_LOCAL_TO_REMOTE     Map Values of Local Attributes in Remote Format             .
IF_UG_MD_VALUE_MAPPING         I MAP_VALUE_REMOTE_TO_LOCAL     Map Values of Remote Attributes in Local Format             .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED            I GET_LAST_START_VALUES         Return Start Values of Last Call                            .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED            I GET_TABLE_OF_DEPGROUP         Determines Dep. Group and Fills Table with Attribute Key    .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED            I INITIALIZE                    Initialization                                              .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED            I NAMED_GUID                    Is the value being searched a named GUID?                   .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED            I RUN                           Search for Uses                                             .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_HTML_HEADER               Get HTML for Header                                         .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_SCREEN_SETTINGS           Get properties of screen to be displayed                    .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Get buttons for display                                     .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_TOOLBAR_EVENTS            Get events for toolbar                                      .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_TREE_CONTENT              Get structure and content of tree                           .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I GET_TREE_EVENT                Get events for the tree                                     .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I SET_TOOLBAR_HANDLERS          Sets Toolbar Event Handler Methods                          .
IF_UG_MD_WHERE_USED_GUI        I SET_TREE_HANDLERS             Sets Tree Event Handler Methods                             .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT             I GET_NUMBER                    Determine Number of Result Objects                          .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT             I GET_OVERVIEW_RESULT           Overview of Found Uses                                      .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT             I GET_TREE                      Determine Hierarchy of Result Objects                       .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I GET_ALL_USAGES                Returns all uses                                            .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I GET_FIRST_USAGE               Returns the first use found                                 .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I GET_START_VALUES              Returns Values for Which the Where-Used List Was Called     .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I GET_UNNAMED                   Returns info about use of unnamed values                    .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I GET_VALUE_FOR_TREE_INDEX      Returns for an Entry in Tree                                .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Global Attributes                         .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I INIT_RESULT                   Initialization                                              .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I READ_FOR_INDEX                Reads entry acc.to index                                    .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I SET_RESULT                    Add uses                                                    .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_CHAR        I SET_TEXT                      Add Names                                                   .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_EDGE        I GET_USAGE                     Returns all uses                                            .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_EDGE        I INIT_RESULT                   Initialisierung                                             .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_EDGE        I SET_RESULT                    Verwendungen hinzufügen                                     .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_HIER        I GET_ALL_USAGES                Returns all uses                                            .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_HIER        I GET_FIRST_USAGE               Returns the First Use Found                                 .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_HIER        I GET_START_VALUES              Returns Values for Which the Where-Used List Was Called     .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_HIER        I INIT_RESULT                   Initialization                                              .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_HIER        I SET_RESULT                    Add uses                                                    .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_TX          I GET_MESSAGES                  Returns message table                                       .
IF_UG_MD_WU_RESULT_TX          I SET_RESULT                    Add uses                                                    .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I CONVERT_OUTPUT                Output Conversion                                           .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_DSFIELD_STATIC            Get DataSource Field (possible only after registration!)    .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_DSFIELD_TO_FIELDNAME      Get DataSource Field for a Field Name                       .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_DSOURCE_PROP              Reads properties for DataSources                            .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_FIELDNAME_STATIC          Get Field Name (possible only after registration!)          .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_FIELDNAME_TO_DATASOURCE   Get Field Name for a DataSource                             .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_FIELDNAME_TO_DSFIELD      Get Field Name for a DataSource Field                       .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_FPROP                     Reads DS Field Properties                                   .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_TEXTS                     Gets Texts for DataSource                                   .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I GET_TIMESTAMPS                Gets Time Stamp for DataSources                             .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I IS_DUMMY                      Check if field name is a dummy field                        .
IF_UG_R3_SERVICES              I SHOW_F1_HELP                  Display F1 help                                             .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_FIELD_DESCRIPTION         Get Semantic Description of a Table Field                   .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_FIELD_ROLE                Get role for a field name                                   .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_FIELD_SUBOBJECT           Special Subobjects for a Field                              .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_FIELD_TABNAME             Get Special Table Names for Field                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_TARGET_FIELD              Get Target Field in Field Catalog                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I GET_TARGET_VALUE              Get Target Value for Output Table                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify Data Table                                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPLICATION_CB      I MODIFY_SELECTION              Get / Change Selection Conditions for a Join                .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_FIELD_DESCRIPTION         Get Semantic Description of a Database Field                .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_FIELD_ROLE                Get role for a field name                                   .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_FIELD_SUBOBJECT           Special Subobjects for a Field                              .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_FIELD_TABNAME             Get Special Table Names for Field                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_TARGET_FIELD              Get Field of Output Structure                               .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I GET_TARGET_VALUE              Get Value of Output Table                                   .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I MODIFY_DATA                   Modify Data Table                                           .
IF_UG_SCDT_APPL_CALLBACK       I MODIFY_SELECTION              Get / Change Selection Conditions for a Join                .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I ADD_FIELD                     Add Field to Field Catalog                                  .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I CLEAR                         Reset object                                                .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I CREATE_TABLE_REF              Get Data Reference to an Internal Table                     .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I GET_FIELD_POS                 Get Position of a Field                                     .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I GET_FIELD_PROP                Get Attributes of a Field                                   .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I REMOVE_FIELD                  Delete Field from Field Catalog                             .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I SET_FIELD_PROP                Set Field Properties                                        .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I SET_FPROP                     Fill an Internal Table with Field Properties                .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_CATALOG       I SET_LOG_STRUCNAME             Set Logical Table Names in Nametab                          .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I GET_TARGET_FCAT               Determine Target Field Catalog                              .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I GET_TARGET_FIELD              Determine Field Properties of Target Field                  .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I GET_TARGET_FIELD_POS          Determine Position of Target Field                          .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I GET_TARGET_VALUE              Determine Target Value                                      .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I IS_CONVERSION_NECESSARY       Is a Data Conversion Necessary?                             .
IF_UG_SCDT_FIELD_MAPPING       I IS_MC_POSSIBLE                Is move-corresponding Possible?                             .
IF_UG_SCDT_OBJECT              I GENERATE_SYNC_OBJECT          Generates a Generic Sync.Object                             .
IF_UG_SCDT_OBJECT              I GET_STRUCTURES                Gets the structures tied to object                          .
IF_UG_SCDT_OBJECT              I GET_STRUCTURE_DATA            Gets the data (ITAB) for a structure                        .
IF_UG_SCDT_OBJECT              I GET_STRUCTURE_FIELDCAT        Gets the field catalog per structure                        .
IF_UG_SCDT_OBJECT              I GET_STRUCTURE_HEADER          Gets the header per structure                               .
IF_UG_TIME                     I CONVERT_DATE_2_PERIOD         Get year and period from date                               .
IF_UG_TIME                     I CONVERT_PERIOD                Convert Period from One FYV to Another FYV                  .
IF_UG_TIME                     I CONVERT_PERIOD_2_DATE         Get date from year and period                               .
IF_UG_TIME                     I GET_NEXT_PERIOD               Determine Period Following Immediately the Specified Period .
IF_UG_TIME                     I GET_PREVIOUS_PERIOD           Determine Previous Period to Specified Period               .
IF_UG_WB                       I GET_AREA_HISTORY              Get Object History of a Window Area                         .
IF_UG_WB                       I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_WB                       I GET_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS        Operations the WB is momentarily able to process            .
IF_UG_WB                       I GET_WA_CAPTIONS               Read Title of Work Areas                                    .
IF_UG_WB                       I GET_WA_EXTENSIONS             Subst. for unreliable sy-srows/scols due to docking         .
IF_UG_WB                       I PERFORM_COMMAND               Execute Operation                                           .
IF_UG_WB                       I SET_CONFIGURATION_SET         Define Configuration(s)                                     .
IF_UG_WB                       I SET_FFIX                      Specify Fixed Fields                                        .
IF_UG_WB_APPLICATION_DATA      I SET_APPLICATION_DATA          Pass app-specific data                                      .
IF_UG_WB_CALLBACK              I CALL_PAI_COMMAND              OK Code Processing                                          .
IF_UG_WB_CALLBACK              I ON_DATA_CHANGED               Notify when data changed                                    .
IF_UG_WB_CALLBACK              I SET_PF_STATUS                 Set menu etc.                                               .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I CALL_PAI_COMMAND              Pass the OK code                                            .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I CALL_PBO_BEFORE               Call during PBO (for output of data to the control)         .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I CONNECT                       Connect to Container                                        .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I FREE                          Release Resources                                           .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I LOAD                          Load Customizing Object into the GUI object                 .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_CTRL             I UNLOAD                        Remove Current Cust. Object from GUI Object                 .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_LINE_SELECTION             Event AT LINE_SELECTION                                     .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_PFK                        Event AT PFk                                                .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_SELECTION_SCREEN           Event AT SELECTION-SCREEN                                   .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_TOP_OF_PAGE                Event AT TOP-OF-PAGE                                        .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_TOP_OF_PAGE_DURING_LINE_SELEvent AT TOP-OF-PAGE DURING LINE-SELECTION                  .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I AT_USER_COMMAND               Event AT USER-COMMAND                                       .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I LOAD                          Load Data Object                                            .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I SET_PF_STATUS                 Set Status                                                  .
IF_UG_WB_CUST_LIST             I UNLOAD                        Unload Data Object                                          .
IF_UG_WB_MESSAGE_CALLBACK      I GET_MESSAGE_PROPERTIES        Prompt for properties of a message line                     .
IF_UG_WB_MESSAGE_CALLBACK      I GET_MESSAGE_PROPERTIES_INST   Prompt for properties of a message line                     .
IF_UG_WB_MESSAGE_CALLBACK      I HIGHLIGHT_MESSAGE_CAUSE       Visually highlight or display location of error             .
IF_UG_WB_MESSAGE_CALLBACK      I HIGHLIGHT_MESSAGE_CAUSE_INST  Visually highlight or display location of error             .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I COPY_VALUE_INSTANCE           Copy Data Instance                                          .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I DELETE_VALUE_INSTANCE         Get Data Instance                                           .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_COLUMNS                   Determine Possible Columns                                  .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_COMMANDS                  Determine Possible Actions in Context Menu                  .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_GUI_DATA                  Read GUI Data                                               .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance                                                .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_VALUE_INSTANCE            Get Data Instance                                           .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I GET_VALUE_INSTANCE_BY_KEY     Get Value Instance by Means of Fieldname-Value Key          .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I PERFORM_COMMAND               Execute Action from Context Menu/Toolbar                    .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I REQUEST_KEY                   Query Key                                                   .
IF_UG_WB_NAV_DETAIL_DATA       I SET_GUI_DATA                  Write GUI Data                                              .
IF_UG_WB_REP_REP_CALL          I REPORT_ASSIGNMENT_DIALOG      Call of Popup for Adding/Deleting RRI Recipients            .
IF_UG_WB_REP_REP_CALL          I REPORT_CALL                   Jump to another report, transaction, query, etc.            .
IF_UG_WB_RRI_INT               I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Check authorization for executing an RRI recipient          .
IF_UG_WB_RRI_INT               I CHECK_EXISTENCE               Check existence of an RRI recipient                         .
IF_UG_WB_RRI_INT               I EXECUTE                       Execute RRI report call                                     .
IF_UG_WB_RRI_INT               I GET_TEXT                      Get text for an RRI recipient                               .
IF_UG_WB_RRI_INT               I IS_TRANSPORTABLE              Determine transportability of an RRI recipient              .
IF_UG_WB_URL                   I ADD_SUPPORTED_APPLICATION     Add application to list of supported applications           .
IF_UG_WB_URL                   I GET_DOCU_TO_OBJECT            Documentation text for an object                            .
IF_UG_WB_URL                   I GET_OBJECT_TO_URL             Instance of a URL                                           .
IF_UG_WB_URL                   I GET_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS          Actions that can be taken with an object or URL             .
IF_UG_WB_URL                   I GET_URL_TO_OBJECT             URL of an Instance                                          .
IF_UG_WB_URL_INT               I GET_OBJECT_TO_URL             Instance of a URL                                           .
IF_UG_WB_URL_INT               I GET_POSSIBLE_ACTIONS          Actions that can be taken with an object or URL             .
IF_UG_WB_URL_INT               I GET_URL_TO_OBJECT             URL of an Instance                                          .
IF_UI_CALLBACK_DME             I PROCESS_COMMAND               Performs Command                                            .
IF_UI_CALLBACK_DME             I REFRESH_UI_DATA               Updates Diplayed Data                                       .
IF_UI_ELEMENT_DME              I DISPLAY                       Redisplays UI Element                                       .
IF_UI_ELEMENT_DME              I QUIT                          Ends UI Element Display                                     .
IF_UI_ELEMENT_DME              I SET_EDITABLE                  Sets Status: UI Element is Editable/Read-Only               .
IF_UI_ELEMENT_DME              I SET_VISIBLE                   Sets Status: UI Element is Visible/Invisible                .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_CALLBACK_DME  I CHANGE_FIELDS                 Change and Check Fields                                     .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I GET_VALUE                     Passes Value of Specified Field                             .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I IS_FIELD_EDITABLE             True "==" Specified Field is Editable                       .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I IS_FIELD_VISIBLE              True "==" Specified Field is Visible                        .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I SET_CREATE_MODE               Sets Create Mode                                            .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I SET_FIELD_EDITABLE            Sets Status: Specified Field is Editable/Read-Only          .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I SET_FIELD_VISIBLE             Sets Status: Specified Field is Visible/Invisible           .
IF_UI_FIELD_LIST_DME           I SET_VALUE                     Sets Specified Value of Specified Field                     .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I DELETE_LINE                   Deletes a Row                                               .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I HIGHLIGHT_LINE                Highlights a Row                                            .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I IS_FIELD_EDITABLE             True "==" Specified Field is Editable                       .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I IS_FIELD_VISIBLE              True "==" Specified Field is Visible                        .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I SET_FIELD_EDITABLE            Sets Status: Specified Field is Editable/Read-Only          .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I SET_FIELD_VISIBLE             Sets Status: Specified Field is Visible/Invisible           .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I SET_LINE                      Sets a Row                                                  .
IF_UI_TABLE_CONTROL_DME        I SET_TABLE                     Sets the Table                                              .
IF_UI_TC_CALLBACK_DME          I CHANGE_LINE                   Change and Check Row                                        .
IF_UI_TC_CALLBACK_DME          I CREATE_LINE                   Create and Check Row                                        .
IF_UI_TC_CALLBACK_DME          I DELETE_LINE                   Delete and Check Row                                        .
IF_UI_TC_CALLBACK_DME          I SELECT_LINE                   Choose row                                                  .
IF_UI_TREE_CALLBACK_DME        I EXECUTE                       Performs a Command on a Node                                .
IF_UI_TREE_CALLBACK_DME        I EXPAND                        Puts Subtree Under Specified Node in UI                     .
IF_UI_TREE_CALLBACK_DME        I GET_APPLICABLE_COMMANDS       Gets Valid Commands for Selected Nodes                      .
IF_UI_TREE_CALLBACK_DME        I SELECT                        Performs the Operations Required to Select Nodes            .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I ADD_COLUMNS                   Adds a Description Column to the Tree                       .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I ADD_NODES                     Puts the Specified Node in the Tree                         .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I DELETE_ALL_NODES              Deletes All Nodes from the Tree                             .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I DELETE_NODES                  Deletes Specified Nodes from the Tree                       .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I EXPAND_NODE                   Expands one Node                                            .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I MARK_NODE                     Node Highlight Toggle                                       .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I MOVE_NODE                     Moves Node                                                  .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I SELECT_NODE                   Selects a Node                                              .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I SET_TEXT                      Changes the Text of an Item                                 .
IF_UI_TREE_DME                 I UPDATE                        Resets the Attributes of Several Nodes and Items            .
IF_UKM_CALCULATOR              I EVALUATE_CREDIT_LIMIT         Calculate Credit Limit                                      .
IF_UKM_CALCULATOR              I EVALUATE_OWN_RATING           Calculate Score                                             .
IF_UKM_CALCULATOR              I EVALUATE_RISK_CLASS           Determine Risk Class                                        .
IF_UKM_CALCULATOR              I GET_RULE_DETAILS              Get Trace Flag and Validity Period                          .
IF_UKM_CALCULATOR              I SAVE_LOGS                     Save Logs (Traces) for Calculation                          .
IF_UKM_CMA_PUSH                I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_UKM_CMA_PUSH                I PUSH_CMA                      Save Credit Management Master Data                          .
IF_UKM_CMA_QUERY               I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP                            .
IF_UKM_CMA_QUERY               I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface from SAP to XI                           .
IF_UKM_CMA_QUERY               I GET_DATA                      Read Credit Management Account Data                         .
IF_UKM_COMMITMENT_PULL         I PULL_COMMITMENT               Get Liability Changes for One or More Partners              .
IF_UKM_COMMITMENT_PUSH         I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_UKM_COMMITMENT_PUSH         I PUSH_COMMITMENT               Report Liability Change                                     .
IF_UKM_COMMITMENT_PUSH_R3      I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface to XI                                    .
IF_UKM_COMMITMENT_PUSH_R3      I PUSH_COMMITMENT               Report Liability Change                                     .
IF_UKM_CREDIT_INFORMER         I EXECUTE_MONITOR               Request External Credit Monitoring Information (Synchronous).
IF_UKM_CREDIT_INFORMER         I PROVIDE_CREDIT_INFO           Provide Credit Information                                  .
IF_UKM_CREDIT_INFORMER         I PULL_MONITOR                  Request External Credit Monitoring Information (Synchronous).
IF_UKM_CREDIT_INFORMER         I SEARCH_ID                     Request Unique External ID for Business Partner             .
IF_UKM_CREDIT_QUERY            I CHECK_CREDIT                  Read Rating and (Possibly) Credit Limit, Execute Credit Chks.
IF_UKM_CREDIT_QUERY            I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP                            .
IF_UKM_CREDIT_QUERY            I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface from SAP to XI                           .
IF_UKM_CREDIT_QUERY_R3         I CHECK_CREDIT                  Execute Credit Check                                        .
IF_UKM_CRITICAL_ACCOUNTS_QUERY I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP                            .
IF_UKM_CRITICAL_ACCOUNTS_QUERY I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface from SAP to XI                           .
IF_UKM_CRITICAL_ACCOUNTS_QUERY I GET_CRITICAL_ACCOUNTS         Read Critical Accounts                                      .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_BLOCK_REASON_TEXT         Read Text for Lock Reason                                   .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_CHECK_STEPS               Read Individual Steps for Check Rule                        .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_CREDIT_SGMNT              Read Credit Segment (Customizing)                           .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_CREDIT_SGMNTS             Read All Credit Segments in Range                           .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_DEFAULT_RULES             Read Default Rule and Default Check Rule                    .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_EXTID_TYPE                Determine Ext. ID Cat. Using Limit Rule and Rating Method   .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_GRADES                    Return Ratings for a Rating Procedure                       .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_GRADE_METHODS             Read Rating Procedures for Rule                             .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_LOGGING                   Read Scope of Logging                                       .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_MAIN_CREDIT_SGMNT         Read Main Credit Segment                                    .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_RISK_CLASS_TEXT           Read Text for Risk Class                                    .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_RULES_USING_BW            Determine All Rules that Use BW Scoring                     .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_RULE_TEXT                 Read Text for Rule (Example: Formula)                       .
IF_UKM_CUSTOMIZING             I GET_SYSTEMS_OF_GROUP          Determine Logical Systems of System Group                   .
IF_UKM_EASY                    I ADD                           Addition of key mappings                                    .
IF_UKM_EASY                    I CLEANUP                       Reset of internal buffer                                    .
IF_UKM_EASY                    I DELETE                        Deletion of key mappings                                    .
IF_UKM_EASY                    I GET                           Query of key mappings                                       .
IF_UKM_EASY                    I SAVE                          Transfer to the posting module                              .
IF_UKM_EVENT_PUBLISHER         I PUBLISH_EVENT                 Publish Events Outside Credit Management                    .
IF_UKM_EVENT_PUBLISHER         I TRIGGER_EVENTS                Send Collected Events                                       .
IF_UKM_EXTERNAL_SCORING_GET    I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_UKM_EXTERNAL_SCORING_GET    I WRITE_EXTERNAL_SCORING        Save External Rating in CR                                  .
IF_UKM_FORMULA_FINDER          I GET_CONVERSION_RISK_CLASS     Determine Conversion Table for Risk Classes                 .
IF_UKM_FORMULA_FINDER          I GET_FORMULA_LIMIT             Determine Formula for Limit Calculation                     .
IF_UKM_FORMULA_FINDER          I GET_FORMULA_RATING            Determine Formula for Scoring                               .
IF_UKM_PROCESS_FINDER          I GET_BLOCK_REASON              Determines Block Reason Dependent on Event                  .
IF_UKM_PROCESS_FINDER          I GET_CONSECUTIVE_PROCESSES     Determines Follow-On Processes of Event                     .
IF_UKM_PROCESS_FINDER          I IS_EVENT_ACTIVE               Checks whether an event is to be handled internally/external.
IF_UKM_SCORING_INFORMER        I PROVIDE_SCORING               Export and Send Score                                       .
IF_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH             I CONVERT_INBOUND               Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH             I CONVERT_INBOUND_2             Inbound Interface from XI to SAP Credit Management          .
IF_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH             I PUSH_VECTOR                   Update Payment Behavior Summaries                           .
IF_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH_R3          I CONVERT_OUTBOUND              Outbound Interface Client to XI                             .
IF_UKM_VECTOR_PUSH_R3          I PUSH_VECTOR                   Report FI Summary                                           .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I AUTH_CHECK                    Checks the Authorization for BSC Element                    .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I BUILD                         Creates 'Dependent' Objects                                 .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I BW_REGISTER                   Register Data to be Read From BW in the BW Interface        .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I CALCULATE_SCORE               Calculates Score and Checks Calculated Status               .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I COMPARE_KEY                   Tests if Object's Key is Equal to Given Key                 .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I COMPARE_TK                    Tests if Object is Equal to Given Type and Key              .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I CREATE_HREF                   Create Unique Reference                                     .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I FREE                          Releases the Instance                                       .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_ATTR                      Provides Some General Attributes for Given Period           .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_DEFINITION                Definition Text                                             .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_NAME_TXT                  Gets Name of Object                                         .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_OWNER                     Get Textual Representation of Owner                         .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_STATUS                    Gets Score, Status or Icon                                  .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_STATUS_TREND              Gets Status Trend Icon                                      .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_TIME_SER_DATA             Get time series in form of column-based table               .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I GET_TYPE_TXT                  Gets Short Type Text                                        .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I LOAD                          Loads Oobject's Time-Dependent Data                         .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I LOCK                          Try to Lock Object in DB                                    .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I RAISE_DATA_CHANGED            Raises Event                                                .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I REINIT                        Reinitialize Instance for new Period                        .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I SAVE                          Saves Object's Time-Dependent Data                          .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I SET_CURPER                    Sets New Value for Current Period                           .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I SET_TARPER                    Sets New Value for Target Period                            .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I UNLOCK                        Unlock DB                                                   .
IF_UMB_BSC_OBJECT              I VALID                         Test if Object's Data is still Valid = DB has not changed   .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I CHECK                         Check Data Consistency                                      .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I CLEANUP                       Cleanup Object Attributes                                   .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I CREATE                        Create New Object                                           .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I DELETE                        Delete Object from DB                                       .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I IS_MODIFIED                   Is Data Modified                                            .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I READ_FROM_DB                  Read Data from Database                                     .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I SAVE                          Save Object                                                 .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I SELECT                        Set Object Attributes                                       .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I SET_UPDATED_STATE             Set to Updated State                                        .
IF_UMB_WIZARD_DATA_MODEL       I WRITE_TO_DB                   Write Data to Database                                      .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I CANCEL                        Cancel Customizing                                          .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I CHECK                         Check Data Consistency                                      .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I END                           End Customizing                                             .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I IS_MODIFIED                   Is Data Modified                                            .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I READ_FROM_DB                  Read Data from Database                                     .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I READ_FROM_DB_DETAIL           Read Detail Data from Database                              .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I SET_UPDATED_STATE             Set to Updated State                                        .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I START                         Start Customizing                                           .
IF_UMC_CUSTOMIZE               I WRITE_TO_DB                   Write Data to Database                                      .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_BOX_DELETED             Event: Bos and Subboxes Were Deleted                        .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_BOX_EXPANDED            Event: Box was Expanded / Collapsed                         .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_COL_LEGEND_FLIPPED      Event: Color Legend Was Switched On/Off                     .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_NAVIGATION_FLIPPED      Event: Navigation Legend Was Switched On/Off                .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_ORIENTATION_CHANGED     Event: Orientation Was Changed                              .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_STATUS_LEGEND_FLIPPED   Event: Status Legend Was Switched On/Off                    .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_SUBBOXES_DELETED        Event: Subboxes Were Deleted                                .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I EVENT_ZOOM_CHANGED            Event: Zoom Was Changed                                     .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_APPLET_TAG_PARAMETER      Gets Parameter for Applet-Tag as String                     .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_BOX_STATUS                Supplies Status                                             .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_BOX_STATUS_X              Gets Status in XString                                      .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_BUTTON_TEXT               Gets Text for Pushbutton                                    .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_COLOR_LEGEND              Gets Color Legend                                           .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_INITIAL_XML_TREE          Gets Initial Tree in XML Format                             .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_INITIAL_XML_TREE_X        Gets Initial Tree in XML Format in XString                  .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_LEGEND_TITLE              Gets Title for Color Legend                                 .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_NAVIGATION_TITLE          Gets Navigation Title                                       .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_NEW_XML_TREE              Gets New Tree in XML Format                                 .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_NEW_XML_TREE_X            Gets New Tree in XML Format in XString                      .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_STATUS_LEGEND             Gets Status Legend                                          .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_XML_CONTEXT_MENU          Gets Context Menu in XML Format                             .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_XML_CONTEXT_MENU_X        Gets Context Menu in XML Format in XString                  .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_XML_DRILLDOWN             Gets New Tree in XML Format                                 .
IF_UMC_ORGCHART_JAVA_APPLET    I GET_XML_SUBTREE               Gets New Tree in XML Format                                 .
IF_UMG_ASSIGN_LANG             I ASSIGN_LANG                   assign lang to text                                         .
IF_UMG_ASSIGN_LANG             I CHECK_LANGCP_LIST             set langcodepage list                                       .
IF_UMG_ASSIGN_LANG             I CLEAN_UP                      clear some internal data which have been collected          .
IF_UMG_ASSIGN_LANG             I GET_FILLEDBY                  Front end should get this info                              .
IF_UMG_ASSIGN_LANG             I SET_EXTRA_PARAMS              set extra params, for example, for vocab import             .
IF_UMM_OBSERVER                I UPDATE                        Update myself                                               .
IF_UMM_SINGLETON               I GET_INSTANCE                  Get one and only one instance                               .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_CHILDREN                  Children                                                    .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_INSTANCE                  Return Instance of the Class                                .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_PARENT                    Parent                                                      .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_PATH_TO_ROOT              Path From Node to Root(s)                                   .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_ROOT_NODES                List of Available Root Nodes                                .
IF_UMR_ORG_HIER                I GET_SUBTREE                   Root and all Subnodes                                       .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I BUILD                         Build the Target System                                     .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_ATTR                      Get attributes of TS like name, owner,􏑞                    .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_CURPER                    Get Current Period                                          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_INSTANCE                  Create instance of target system (return null if not valid) .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_MEASURES                  Get list of active measures with respect to curper          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_MEASURE_ATTR              Get Attr. of Measure: Txt, Owner, Formula+Agrs, Mapping     .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_MEASURE_BW_DATA           Get BW data for required value fields of the measure        .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_MEASURE_COLUMNS           Get Value Fields of the Measure                             .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_MEASURE_UNIT              Get runtime unit of measure                                 .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_PERIOD_STATE              Return Status for Given Period (Open / Close)               .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_RM_ACTIVE_FLAG            Get status of RM active flag from TS master                 .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_TARPER                    Get Target Period                                           .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I GET_TIME                      Get time object used in TS                                  .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS              I SET_PERIODS                   Set New Current and Target Periods                          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I DELETE_TARGET_SYSTEM          Delete all Data Related to Target System                    .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_ATTR                      Get attributes of TS like name, owner,􏑞                    .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_COLUMNS                   Get List of all Columns Used in TS                          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_CPM_VARIABLES             Return CPM Variable Values of TS                            .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_CURPER                    Get Current Period                                          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_EST_COL                   Return List of Estimation Value Fields                      .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_FISCAL_VARIANT            Return Fiscal Variant                                       .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_HIERARCHY                 Provide sub-hierarchy of the element                        .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_INSTANCE                  Create instance of target system (return null if not valid) .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_MEASURES                  Get list of active measures with respect to curper          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_MEASURE_ATTR              Get Attr. of Measure: Txt, Owner, Formula+Agrs, Mapping     .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_MEASURE_COLUMNS           Get Value Fields of the Measure                             .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_RM_ACTIVE_FLAG            Get status of RM active flag from TS master                 .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_TARGET_SYS_NAME           Returns common name of target system                        .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_TARPER                    Get Target Period                                           .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_TIME                      Get time object used in TS                                  .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I GET_USE_RACT                  Return Flag if Risk Activities are used or not              .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I SELECT_TARGET_SYSTEM          Ask user to select one target system and return selection   .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I SET_PERIODS                   Set New Current and Target Periods                          .
IF_UMR_TARGET_SYS_CUST         I SET_RM_ACTIVE_FLAG            Set RM active flag in TS master                             .
IF_UNIQUE_INSTANCE_MM          I GET_KEY                       Return a Unique Key Describing the Instance                 .
IF_UNIT_CONVERTER_S2L          I TO_BASE_UOM                   Convert a Quantity to Base Unit of Measure                  .
IF_UNIT_CONVERTER_S2L          I TO_USED_UOM                   Convert Quantity to Unit of Measure to Be Used              .
IF_UNIT_CONVERTER_S2L          I USED_UOM                      Gets the Unit of Measure to Be Used                         .
IF_UNKNOWN                     I QUERY_INTERFACE               Returns Interface Reference                                 .
IF_UPB_POFO_PROVIDE            I GET_ATTR                      Read Other Attributes for Portfolio Graphic                 .
IF_UPB_POFO_PROVIDE            I GET_CUST                      Read Customizing Template                                   .
IF_UPB_POFO_PROVIDE            I GET_DATA                      Delivers Data for IGS Mapping                               .
IF_UPB_POFO_PROVIDE            I GET_HIDDEN                    Table of Hidden Bubbles                                     .
IF_UPB_POFO_PROVIDE            I RESET                         Invalidate Buffer                                           .
IF_UPDATE_STRATEGY_CK          I CONTINUE                      Is the Cost Estimate to be Notified                         .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Messages                                             .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I DISPLAY                       Display Messages                                            .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I GET_DOCNUM_OF_ITEM            Determine Message ID for Object in UPS                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I PROCESS                       Process Messages                                            .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I READ_DISTRIBUTION_MODEL       Check Distributability                                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I SELECT_RECEIPTS               Select Unposted Receipts in Inbox                           .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I SEND_DELIVERY_NOTE            Send UPS Delivery Note                                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I SEND_RECEIPT                  Send Receipt                                                .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I SETUP_EVENT_REGISTRATION      Determine Necessary Event Registries                        .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I STATUS_READ                   Read Status of Messages                                     .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE              I STATUS_ROLE                   Role of Status in UPS                                       .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_CONFIG       I SETUP_EVENT_REGISTRATION      Determine Necessary Event Registries                        .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_CONFIG       I SETUP_REPORTS                 Reports for the SETUP                                       .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Messages                                             .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I DISPLAY                       Display Messages                                            .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I GET_DOCNUM_OF_ITEM            Determine Message ID for Object in UPS                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I PROCESS                       Process Messages                                            .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I READ_DISTRIBUTION_MODEL       Check Distributability                                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I RUNTIME_REPORTS               Program for Runtime                                         .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I SELECT_RECEIPTS               Select Unposted Receipts in Inbox                           .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I SEND_DELIVERY_NOTE            Send UPS Delivery Note                                      .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I SEND_MESSAGES                 Send Object Messages                                        .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I SEND_RECEIPT                  Send Receipt                                                .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I STATUS_READ                   Read Status of Messages                                     .
IF_UPS_MIDDLEWARE_RUNTIME      I STATUS_ROLE                   Role of Status in UPS                                       .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I CHECK                         Consistency Check                                           .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I DOM_TO_APPLICATION            Loads Application from DOM                                  .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_APPLICATION_NAME          Name of Application                                         .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Web & Exc: Delivers Attributes of BSP Page                  .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_BSP_PAGE                  Web: Delivers BSP Page on Generation                        .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_BSP_RENDER                Web: Delivers BSP Page During Dynamic Rendering             .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_COMPONENT_BY_ID           Delivers Components By Name                                 .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_COMPONENT_LIST            Returns Subcomponents                                       .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_CURRENT_PAGE              Current Page (HTML Name)                                    .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_PAGE                      Delivers Page                                               .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_PAGE_NAME                 Delivers Page Name, Main Page for Application               .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I GET_ROOT_INSTANCE             Generation / Constructor                                    .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I INITIALIZE                    Web: Initialization at Runtime of BSP Application           .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_APPLICATION_NAME          Name of Application                                         .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_CLSNAME                   Web: Sets Name of Generated BSP ABAP OO Class               .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_CURRENT_PAGE              Current Page (HTML Name)                                    .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_DEVCLASS                  Sets the Package                                            .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_FLAG_GEN_CLASS            Web: Generation of Class                                    .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_OTR_PACKAGES              Sets OTR Packages                                           .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I SET_TITLE                     Description of Application                                  .
IF_UPWB_APPLICATION            I TO_XML_DOM                    Serialization in XML Format                                 .
IF_UPWB_BSP_APPL               I GET_COMPONENT                 Returns Reference to Component                              .
IF_UPWB_BSP_APPL               I INITIALIZATION                Is Called Up During Event of Same Name of BSP Page          .
IF_UPWB_BSP_APPL               I INPUTPROCESSING               Is Called Up During Event PAI of BSP Page                   .
IF_UPWB_BSP_APPL               I MANIPULATION                  Is Called Up During Event of BSP Page                       .
IF_UPWB_BSP_APPL               I REGISTER_HANDLER              Registers Event Handler on BSP page (See Constants)         .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I ACTIVATE_SICF_ENTRY           Activates an HTTP Service Entry                             .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I CHECK_SICF_FOR_SEM_UPWB       OBSOLETE: Checks Whether SICF Entry Exists for SEM_UPWB     .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I CREATE_SICF_ENTRY             OBSOLETE: Generates an HTTP Service Entry                   .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I GET_INSTANCE                  Returns Only Instance                                       .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I GET_MSG_LOG                   Delivers Reference to Message Log                           .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I GET_PLANNING_APP              Retuens Current Application                                 .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I GET_SICF_STATUS               Delivers Status Regarding HTTP Service                      .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I GET_STORAGE                   Delivers Reference to Storage                               .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER                I OPEN_APPLICATION              Opens Current Application                                   .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I ACTIVATE                      ACTIVATE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I CHECK                         CHECK                                                       .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I CHECK_EDITABLE                Editable because of System Settings?                        .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I GENERATE                      Generate                                                    .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I GENERATE_DIALOG               Dialog to Ascertain Parameters for Generation               .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I INITIALIZE                    INITIALIZE                                                  .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_GENERATOR      I IS_VALID_NAME                 IS_VALID_NAME                                               .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_PREVIEW        I GET_SHOW_PREVIEW              Returns whether the Preview Is Active                       .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_PREVIEW        I REFRESH                       Is Called Up if the Components in the Builder Change        .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_PREVIEW        I SET_PREVIEW_TYPE              Sets Type of Previewer                                      .
IF_UPWB_BUILDER_PREVIEW        I SET_SHOW_PREVIEW              Sets Preview Active/Inactive                                .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I CLONE                         Deep Copy                                                   .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I CREATE_ID                     Creates New Unique ID (Using Class Name or Template)        .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I EDIT_PROPERTY                 Runs the Property Editor for the Property                   .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I FINALIZE                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_BPS_DESCRIPTION           Delivers Description of BPS Object of Property              .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_CHILDREN                  Returns Subcomponents                                       .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_CHILDREN_COUNT            Returns Subcomponents                                       .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_CLASS_DESCRIPTION         Delivers Class Description                                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_CLASS_NAME                Returns Class Name                                          .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_CLASS_TEMPLATE            Returns Table of Source Code                                .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_EDIT_TYPE                 Returns Type for Editing (Const. Hidden,Editable,Read Only) .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_EXPANDED_ICON             Note Presentation in Tree Control                           .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_FIRST_CHILD               Returns First Subcomponent                                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_HTML_NAME                 Returns HTML Name (like "componentID".htm)                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_ID                        Long ID (Unique)                                            .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_INTERFACE_NAME            Returns Class Name                                          .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_METHOD_COUNT              Delivers Number of Methods                                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_METH_DESCR                Delivers a Method Description                               .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_METH_DESCRIPTORS          Delivers All Method Descriptions                            .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_NEXT                      Delivers Next Subcomponent                                  .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_NORMAL_ICON               Note Presentation in Tree Control                           .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_PARENT                    Delivers Higher-Level Component                             .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_PROPERTY                  Delivers Value of a Property                                .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_PROPERTY_COUNT            Delivers Number of Properties                               .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_PROP_DESCR                Delivers a Certain Property Description                     .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I GET_PROP_DESCRIPTORS          Delivers All Property Descriptions                          .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I IS_FOLDER                     For Display in Tree Control                                 .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I IS_SUBCLASS_OF                Test on Subclass Property                                   .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I NEW_CHILD                     Automatically Creates a New Subcomponent                    .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I PASTE                         Paste Operation                                             .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I REMOVE                        Rmove                                                       .
IF_UPWB_COMPONENT              I SET_PROPERTY                  Sets the Value of a Property                                .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_CURRENT_PAGE              GET_CURRENT_PAGE                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_HTML_NAME                 GET_HTML_NAME                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_PROFILE                   Get Planning Profile                                        .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_QUERY_STRING              URL Query String with Standard Parameters                   .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_REFRESH_TIME              GET_REFRESH_TIME                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_TIMEOUT                   GET_TIMEOUT                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_USE_UNLOAD                Using Unload Events                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I GET_XML_VERSION               XML Version                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I SET_CURRENT_PAGE              SET_CURRENT_PAGE                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I SET_PROFILE                   Set Planning Profile                                        .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I SET_REFRESH_TIME              SET_REFRESH_TIME                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I SET_TIMEOUT                   SET_TIMEOUT                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_APPLICATION          I SET_USE_UNLOAD                Using Unload Events                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_BUTTON               I GET_DISABLED                  Disabled                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_BUTTON               I SET_DISABLED                  Disabled                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_BUTTON               I SUBMIT                        SUBMIT                                                      .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I EXECUTE                       EXECUTE                                                     .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I GET_GL_SEQUENCE               GET_GL_SEQUENCE                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I GET_LABEL                     GET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I GET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I SET_GL_SEQUENCE               SET_GL_SEQUENCE                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I SET_LABEL                     SET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_FUNCTION         I SET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_NAVIGATION       I GET_PAGE                      GET_PAGE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_NAVIGATION       I SET_PAGE                      SET_PAGE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_UNDO             I GET_UNDO                      State of Undo (if True, Components Do Not Process Input)    .
IF_UPWB_C_BUT_UNDO             I SET_UNDO                      State of Undo (if True, Components Do Not Process Input)    .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I API_GET_DATA                  API_GET_DATA                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_BG_COLOR                  BG Color                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_GROUP_COLUMNS             Group by Layout Columns or Group by Rows                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_HEIGHT                    Size of Area for Graph (Applet)                             .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_LEGEND_POSITION           Legend Position                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_TITLE                     Title                                                       .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_TYPE                      Graph Type                                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I GET_WIDTH                     Size of Area for Graph (Applet)                             .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I PREPARE_OUTPUT                PREPARE_OUTPUT                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_BG_COLOR                  BG Color                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_GROUP_COLUMNS             Group by Layout Columns or Group by Rows                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_HEIGHT                    Size of Area for Graph (Applet)                             .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_LEGEND_POSITION           Legend Position                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_TITLE                     Title                                                       .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_TYPE                      Graph Type                                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_CHART                I SET_WIDTH                     Size of Area for Graph (Applet)                             .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I ADD_CHILD                     ADD_CHILD                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_APPLICATION               GET_APPLICATION                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_CHILDREN                  GET_CHILDREN                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_CHILDREN_COUNT            GET_CHILDREN_COUNT                                          .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_CHILD_NUMBER              My Number in the Parent's List                              .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_CLASS                     GET_CLASS                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_COMPONENT                 GET_COMPONENT                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_ID                        GET_ID                                                      .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_PARENT                    GET_PARENT                                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I GET_VISUAL                    'true' if Component Is Going to Be Rendered                 .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I REMOVE                        REMOVE                                                      .
IF_UPWB_C_COMPONENT            I SET_VISUAL                    'true' if Component Is Going to Be Rendered                 .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_COLUMNS                   GET_COLUMNS                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_CSS_CLASS                 CSS Class that Wraps the Container                          .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_ROWS                      GET_ROWS                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_SPACING                   Spacing among Cells                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_TABLE_CSS_CLASS           CSS Class for Grid (Table)                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_USE_GRID                  GET_USE_GRID                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I GET_VERTICAL                  GET_VERTICAL                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_COLUMNS                   SET_COLUMNS                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_CSS_CLASS                 CSS Class that Wraps the Container                          .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_ROWS                      SET_ROWS                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_SPACING                   Spacing among Cells                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_TABLE_CSS_CLASS           CSS Class for Grid (Table)                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_USE_GRID                  SET_USE_GRID                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_CONTAINER            I SET_VERTICAL                  SET_VERTICAL                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_DOCUMENT             I PREPARE_DOCUMENT              GET_DOCUMENT                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_DOCUMENT             I PROCESS_DOCUMENT              PROCESS_DOCUMENT                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I GET_AREA                      GET_AREA                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I GET_LEVEL                     GET_LEVEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I GET_PACKAGE                   GET_PACKAGE                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I GET_PACKAGE_SELECTOR          GET_PACKAGE_SELECTOR                                        .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I SET_AREA                      SET_AREA                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I SET_LEVEL                     SET_LEVEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_ENTITY               I SET_PACKAGE                   SET_PACKAGE                                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I GET_LABEL                     GET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I GET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST           Run Server Event If the Body Is Selected (Space=No Toggle)  .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I GET_OPENED                    Body Is Visible                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I GET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I PROCESS_STATE                 State of Body Visibility                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I SET_LABEL                     SET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I SET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST           Run Server Event If the Body Is Selected (Space=No Toggle)  .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I SET_OPENED                    Body Is Visible                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_GROUP                I SET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I API_GET_DATA                  API_GET_DATA                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I API_SET_DATA                  API_PUT_DATA                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_ALLOW_DROPDOWN            Allow Dropdowns for New Lines                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_ALLOW_NEW_LINES           GET_ALLOW_NEW_LINES                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_DATA_ROWS                 Number of Rows in Data Area (not Contain New Rows)          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_DETAIL_ENABLED            GET_DETAIL_ENABLED                                          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW         GET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW                                       .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_FUNCTION                  Function Called After Data Change                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_HEADER_ROWS               OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_HEIGHT                    Height of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                 .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_NEW_ROWS                  Number of New Rows to Be Added                              .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_READ_ONLY                 GET_READ_ONLY                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_SELECTED_COLUMN           GET_SELECTED_COLUMN                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_SELECTED_ROW              GET_SELECTED_ROW                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_SELECTION                 GET_SELECTION                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_SHOW_FOOTER               Display footer line                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_USE_EXCEL                 Excel Web Component                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_VISIBLE_ROWS              GET_VISIBLE_ROWS                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I GET_WIDTH                     Width of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                  .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I PREPARE_OUTPUT                PREPARE_OUTPUT                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I PROCESS_INPUT                 PROCESS_INPUT                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_ALLOW_DROPDOWN            Allow Dropdowns for New Lines                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_ALLOW_NEW_LINES           SET_ALLOW_NEW_LINES                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_DETAIL_ENABLED            SET_DETAIL_ENABLED                                          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW         SET_FIRST_VISIBLE_ROW                                       .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_FUNCTION                  Function Called After Data Change                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_HEADER_ROWS               OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_HEIGHT                    Height of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                 .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_READ_ONLY                 SET_READ_ONLY                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_SHOW_FOOTER               Display footer line                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_USE_EXCEL                 Excel Web Component                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_VISIBLE_ROWS              SET_VISIBLE_ROWS                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I SET_WIDTH                     Width of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                  .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT               I XLS_ERR_PREPARE_OUTP          xls_err_prepare_outp                                        .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_COMPRESS_LEADCOL          Compress leading columns into one column                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_DATA_ROWS                 Number of Rows in Data Area (not Contain New Rows)          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_DETAIL_TOOLTIP            Quick Info for Detail Button                                .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_FUNCTION                  Function Called After Data Change                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_HEIGHT                    Height of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                 .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_NEW_ROWS                  Number of New Rows to Be Added                              .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_SHOW_FOOTER               Display footer line                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_USE_EXCEL                 Excel Web Component                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_VLHELP                    Value help string ("default"&"chanm"="design"&...)          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_WIDTH                     Width of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                  .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I GET_WRAP_ENABLED              Areas with the Permitted Wrapping                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I IS_READY_FOR                  Handler should/can/cannot be called                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_COMPRESS_LEADCOL          Compress leading columns into one column                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_DETAIL_TOOLTIP            Quick Info for Detail Button                                .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_FUNCTION                  Function Called After Data Change                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_HEIGHT                    Height of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                 .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_NEW_ROWS                  Number of new rows when inserted                            .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_REQUEST_FOR               Handler shall be called                                     .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_SHOW_FOOTER               Display footer line                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_USE_EXCEL                 Excel Web Component                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_VLHELP                    Value help string ("default"&"chanm"="design"&...)          .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_WIDTH                     Width of Layout (Currently only for Excel)                  .
IF_UPWB_C_LAYOUT2              I SET_WRAP_ENABLED              Areas with the Permitted Wrapping                           .
IF_UPWB_C_LINK                 I GET_LINK                      GET_LINK                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LINK                 I GET_TARGET                    GET_TARGET                                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_LINK                 I SET_LINK                      SET_LINK                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_LINK                 I SET_TARGET                    SET_TARGET                                                  .
IF_UPWB_C_MESSAGE              I GET_MSG_COUNT                 Count the not yet prepared messages in the log              .
IF_UPWB_C_MESSAGE              I GET_SHOW_TECHNICAL            Show technical messages                                     .
IF_UPWB_C_MESSAGE              I PREPARE_MESSAGES              PREPARE_MESSAGES                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_MESSAGE              I SET_SHOW_TECHNICAL            Show technical messages                                     .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I GET_CSS_LINK                  Path to Additional CSS File                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I GET_HTML_NAME                 GET_HTML_NAME                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I GET_STATEFULL                 GET_STATEFULL                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I NAVIGATE_TO_APPLICATION       SET_FRAME_PAGE                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I PREPARE_CONTEXT               PREPARE_CONTEXT                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I SET_CSS_LINK                  Path to Additional CSS File                                 .
IF_UPWB_C_PAGE                 I SET_STATEFULL                 SET_STATEFULL                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_AREA                      GET_AREA                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_DESIGN                    Types: 'Dropdown', 'Hidden', 'Input'                        .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_FORMATTING                GET_FORMATTING                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_LABEL_REF                 Label Reference                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_LINES                     Lines of Dropdown                                           .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I GET_VALUE                     GET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I PREPARE_VALUES                PREPARE_VALUES                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I PROCESS_SELECTION             PROCESS_SELECTION                                           .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_AREA                      SET_AREA                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_DESIGN                    Types: 'Dropdown', 'Hidden', 'Input'                        .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_FORMATTING                SET_FORMATTING                                              .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_LABEL_REF                 Label Reference                                             .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_LINES                     Lines of Dropdown                                           .
IF_UPWB_C_SELECTOR             I SET_VALUE                     SET_VALUE                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_LEVEL            I GET_ENTITIES                  GET_LEVEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_LEVEL            I GET_LEVEL                     GET_LEVEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_LEVEL            I SET_LEVEL                     SET_LEVEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I API_GET_VARIABLE              API_GET_VARIABLE                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I API_SET_VARIABLE              API_SET_VARIABLE                                            .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_CLIENT_EXPAND_LEVEL       Max. level expanded on the client (for new design)          .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_COMPLETE                  GET_COMPLETE                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_EXTERNAL_SOURCE           OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_INTERVAL_FORMAT           GET_INTERVAL_FORMAT                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_LAYOUT2                   Layout Source                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_SOURCE                    Layout Source (Old Type)                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I GET_VARIABLE                  GET_VARIABLE                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_CLIENT_EXPAND_LEVEL       Max. level expanded on the client (for new design)          .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_COMPLETE                  SET_COMPLETE                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_EXTERNAL_SOURCE           OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_INTERVAL_FORMAT           SET_INTERVAL_FORMAT                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_LAYOUT2                   Layout Source                                               .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_SOURCE                    Layout Source (Old Type)                                    .
IF_UPWB_C_SEL_VARVL            I SET_VARIABLE                  SET_VARIABLE                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_TAB_CONTAINER        I GET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST           GET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_TAB_CONTAINER        I SET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST           SET_LOAD_ON_REQUEST                                         .
IF_UPWB_C_TAB_STRIP            I GET_SELECTED                  GET_SELECTED                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_TAB_STRIP            I PROCESS_SELECTION             PROCESS_SELECTION                                           .
IF_UPWB_C_TAB_STRIP            I SET_SELECTED                  SET_SELECTED                                                .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I GET_IMAGE                     GET_IMAGE                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I GET_LABEL                     GET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I GET_LABEL_FOR                 Labeled Component (Usually Selector)                        .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I GET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I GET_USE_HTML                  Use Label and Title as HTML (Do Not Escape)                 .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I SET_IMAGE                     SET_IMAGE                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I SET_LABEL                     SET_LABEL                                                   .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I SET_LABEL_FOR                 Labeled Component (Usually Selector)                        .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I SET_TITLE                     Quick Info (HTML Tag Property 'Title')                      .
IF_UPWB_C_TEXT                 I SET_USE_HTML                  Use Label and Title as HTML (Do Not Escape)                 .
IF_UPWB_GENERATOR              I CHECK                         Checks Whether Generation Works                             .
IF_UPWB_GENERATOR              I FORCE_ACTIVATION              Activates a Class                                           .
IF_UPWB_GENERATOR              I GENERATE                      Executes a Generation                                       .
IF_UPWB_GENERATOR              I IS_VALID_WIF_NAME             Can the Name Be Used for a Web Interface?                   .
IF_UPWB_METH_DESCR             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns Description                                         .
IF_UPWB_METH_DESCR             I GET_NAME                      Delivers the Name                                           .
IF_UPWB_METH_DESCR             I GET_VISUAL_NAME               Delivers the External Presentation of the Name              .
IF_UPWB_MSG_LOG                I ADD                           Add Message                                                 .
IF_UPWB_MSG_LOG                I CLEAR                         Delete Message(s)                                           .
IF_UPWB_MSG_LOG                I DISPLAY                       Display Messages                                            .
IF_UPWB_MSG_LOG                I GET_MSG                       Delivers Message Lines                                      .
IF_UPWB_MSG_LOG                I RAISE                         Add Message and Raise Exception                             .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns Description                                         .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I GET_NAME                      Returns Name                                                .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I GET_TYPE                      Returns Type                                                .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I GET_VISUAL_NAME               Delivers Names in External Format                           .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I GET_XML_NAME                  Returns XML Name                                            .
IF_UPWB_PROP_DESCR             I HAS_PROPERTY_EDITOR           True, If Property Editor Available                          .
IF_UPWB_PROP_EDITOR            I EDIT_VALUE                    Start Editing                                               .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I CHANGE_LOCK                   A Lock Is Set from READ to Write or the other way round     .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I CREATE_WIF_FROM_XML           Generates a New WIF from XML Description                    .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I DELETE                        Deletes an Application via Reference                        .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Delivers the Attributes of a BSP Planning Application       .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I GET_MASTER_DATA               Delivers Master Data of All Available Applications          .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I GET_NAMES                     Delivers the Names of All Available Planning Applications   .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I IS_GENERATED                  Returns True if the Application Was Generated               .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I LOAD                          Loads a Specific Planning Application                       .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I RELEASE_LOCK                  A Lock Is Reset                                             .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I SAVE                          Saves a Specific Planning Application                       .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I SET_LOCK                      A Lock Is Set                                               .
IF_UPWB_STORAGE                I TRANSPORT                     Transports an Individual Planning Application               .
IF_UPWB_VIEW_OBJECT            I DELETE_CONTROLS               Deletes the Controls (If the Container Has Changed)         .
IF_UPWB_VIEW_OBJECT            I DISPLAY                       DISPLAY                                                     .
IF_UPWB_VIEW_OBJECT            I GET_GUI_CONTAINER             Returns GUI Container for Control                           .
IF_UPWB_VIEW_OBJECT            I SET_GUI_CONTAINER             SET_GUI_CONTAINER                                           .
IF_UPX_APPLICATION             I GET_TITLE                     to get the title of the application                         .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I ATRVL                         Get the value of particular attribute                       .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I ATRVL_SET                     Set new value to the buffered attributes                    .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I BASNM                         Get reference characteristic                                .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I BASNM_TEXT                    Get description for reference characteristic                .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I CHANM                         Get characteristic name                                     .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I CHANM_ATR                     Get the list of attributes                                  .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I CHANM_TEXT                    Get description for characteristic                          .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I CHAVL_LIST                    Get the list of characteristic values                       .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I CHAVL_TEXT                    Get description for characteristic value                    .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I DATATP                        Get type of the characteristic                              .
IF_UPX_BW_CHANM                I HIE_LIST                      Get the list of attached hierarchies                        .
IF_UPX_BW_HIE                  I HIE_GET                       Get hierarchy values                                        .
IF_UPX_BW_HIE                  I HIE_KEY                       Get the key for the hierarchy                               .
IF_UPX_BW_HIE                  I HIE_MAINTAIN                  Start BW maintenance for the hierarchy                      .
IF_UPX_BW_HIE                  I HIE_TEXT                      Get hierarchy description                                   .
IF_UPX_CHANM_GROUP             I CHARS                         Return list of Characteristics                              .
IF_UPX_CHANM_GROUP             I DSRC                          Return Pointer to DataSource                                .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I CM_CHILDREN                   Returns a list of subnodes/items                            .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I CM_HANDLE                     Handles command from context menu                           .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I CM_ITEMS                      Returns allowed set of context menu commands                .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I CM_STATUS                     Returns the commands allowed for pf-status                  .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I IS_CHANGED                    Tracks the children if they are changed                     .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I IS_FOLDER                     Is the node folder or leaf?                                 .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I SAVE                          Saves the data beneath the node                             .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I TEXT_GET                      Returns the text of the node                                .
IF_UPX_CM_HANDLER              I TRANSPORT                     Completes the transport table for particular object         .
IF_UPX_CM_VISITOR              I VISIT                         Visit the concrete CM handler                               .
IF_UPX_CUST_COMPONENT          I CONSTRAINS                    to get the list of the required objects                     .
IF_UPX_CUST_COMPONENT          I SAVE                          to extract the XML for persistency                          .
IF_UPX_CUST_COMPONENT          I SUBSCREEN                     to get the proprietor subscreen for the component           .
IF_UPX_CUST_KEY_SELECTOR       I SELECT                        to select the application main key                          .
IF_UPX_CUST_STEP               I ARRANGE_COMPONENTS            Get Arrangement Info about Components                       .
IF_UPX_CUST_STEP               I LIST_COMPONENTS               to get the list of the components within the step           .
IF_UPX_CUST_SUBSCREEN          I CANCEL                        to finish the work, but not save                            .
IF_UPX_CUST_SUBSCREEN          I CHECK                         to check the subscreen before resume                        .
IF_UPX_CUST_SUBSCREEN          I OKCODE                        to manage screen OK code                                    .
IF_UPX_CUST_SUBSCREEN          I PREPARE                       to prepare subscreen to be shown                            .
IF_UPX_CUST_SUBSCREEN          I RESUME                        to finish the work with actual subscreen                    .
IF_UPX_DSRC_GENERIC            I DATA                          Get table of hierarchical data                              .
IF_UPX_DSRC_GENERIC            I FIXED_CHARS                   Get table of fixed characteristics                          .
IF_UPX_DSRC_GENERIC            I STD_CHAR                      Get base standard characteristic                            .
IF_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER           I RENDER                        Render DHTML                                                .
IF_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER           I SAVE                          Save Data                                                   .
IF_UPX_LAYOUT_RENDER           I UPDATE                        Recalculate Cells                                           .
IF_UPX_RESP_SOURCE             I DIMENSION                     Get the characteristic delivered by responsibility          .
IF_UPX_RESP_SOURCE             I FETCH_NEXT                    Get next responsibility object                              .
IF_UPX_RESP_SOURCE             I MOVE_FIRST                    Move iterator to the first responsibility object            .
IF_UPX_RESP_SOURCE             I NEXT_EXISTS                   Is there a next object?                                     .
IF_UPX_SUBSCREEN_PROXY         I CANCEL                        Finish the work but do not save                             .
IF_UPX_SUBSCREEN_PROXY         I CHECK                         Check the data on actual subscreen                          .
IF_UPX_SUBSCREEN_PROXY         I OKCODE                        Manage screen OK code                                       .
IF_UPX_SUBSCREEN_PROXY         I PREPARE                       Prepare subscreen to be shown                               .
IF_UPX_SUBSCREEN_PROXY         I RESUME                        Finish the work with actual subscreen                       .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I COPY                          Copy the texts from another texts object                    .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I DELETE                        Delete all text records                                     .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I NEW                           Create new empty object                                     .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I OPEN                          Open the texts from the table                               .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I SAVE                          Save all changes to the database                            .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I TEXT                          Get the text for current language                           .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I TEXT_BY_LANG                  Get the text for given language                             .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I TEXT_SET                      Set text for current language                               .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I TRANSLATE                     Launch the translator subscreen proxy                       .
IF_UPX_TEXTS                   I TRANSPORT                     Prepare texts to be transported                             .
IF_UPX_TIMEFRAME               I SAVE_DATA                     Save time frame data to the given storage                   .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I CHECK_STATUS                  Check Internal Status and Set DISPLAY                       .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I CLEAR_CHANGED                 Object not changed any more                                 .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I DELETION_POSSIBLE             Deletion of Actual Object Possible?                         .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I DEQUEUE                       Unlock object                                               .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I ENQUEUE                       Lock Object for Maintenance                                 .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I IS_CHANGED                    Object Changed?                                             .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I SET_CHANGED                   Object was changed                                          .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I SET_DELETED                   Set Deletion Flag                                           .
IF_UR_GUI_OBJECT               I UPDATE_GUI_STATUS             Update GUI Status for Display                               .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I COMMIT_DELTA                  Chunk Ready. Make DB Commit                                 .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I DELETE_CHUNK                  Deletes an erroneous chunk from the delta queue             .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I GET_DATA                      Synchronized Reading of Summary Data                        .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I PUT_DELTA_DATA                Writes a group of delta postings to the queue               .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I READ_DATA_FOR_DISPLAY         Read Data for Displaying Realignment Run                    .
IF_UR_TOTALSSOURCE             I UNDO_CHUNK                    Deletes an erroneous chunk from the delta queue             .
IF_USER_DATA_TRG               I DISPLAY                       Displays the Object                                         .
IF_USER_DATA_TRG               I GET_DESCRIPTION               Gets Short Decription of the Object                         .
IF_UWL_ITEM_PROVIDER           I GET_DELTA_ITEMS               get items changed since the indicated timestamp             .
IF_VALIDITY_STRATEGY_CK        I VALID                         Checks Validity                                             .
IF_VALUATION_STEP_VAL          I GET_MESSAGES                  Gets Messages for the Valuation Step                        .
IF_VALUATION_STEP_VAL          I GET_RESET_VALUATION_FLOWS     Gets Valuation Flows for the Reset                          .
IF_VALUATION_STEP_VAL          I GET_VALUATION_FLOWS           Gets Valuation Flows                                        .
IF_VALUATION_STEP_VAL          I GET_VALUATION_INFO            Gets Information for the Valuation Step                     .
IF_VALUATION_STEP_VAL          I VALUE                         Executes the Valuation Step                                 .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I EQUALS                        Checks Whether Two Objects are Identical                    .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I GET_TREE_NODE                 Delivers Reference to Node (No Longer To Be Used)           .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_BUTTON_CLICK          Event Handler: Pushbutton Activated                         .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_EXPAND_NO_CHILDREN    Event Handler: Reload Subtree                               .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_NODE_CONTEXT_MENU     Event Handler: Context Menu (Right Mouse Button)            .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_NODE_CONTEXT_MENU_SEL Event Handler: Context Menu (Function Selected)             .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_NODE_DBL_CLICK        Event Handler: Double Click                                 .
IF_VAR_TREE_NODE_IGN           I PROCESS_SEL_CHANGE            Event Handler: Selection Changed                            .
IF_VB_CHANGES_TRIGGER_FOLLOWUP I VB_CHANGES_TRIGGER_FOLLOW_UP  BAdI in FM VB_CHANGE_DOCUMENT_PREPARE                       .
IF_VECTOR_CALCULATE            I CALCULATE                     Calculate Payment Behavior Summary                          .
IF_VERSION_CREATE_TEM          I CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES             Changes Selected Attributes of Exposure                     .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_COMPLEX_EXPAND_VIEW      Generate View to Expand and Collapse (Complex)              .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_EXPAND_VIEW              Generate View to Expand and Collapse                        .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_QUERY_VIEW               Generate View for Worklist                                  .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_QUICKINFO_EXPAND_VIEW    Generate View to Expand and Collapse                        .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_SIMPLE_FRAME_VIEW        View with Dynamic Frame                                     .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_SIMPLE_MAIN_WINDOW       Main Window (Screen Container) With Standard Menu           .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_SIMPLE_SETUP_VIEW        Generates Setup-Builder                                     .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_SIMPLE_TAB_VIEW          Generate Tabstrip View                                      .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_SIMPLE_TOGGLE_VIEW       Generate View with Text Label Subview and Detail Subview    .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_TABLE_VIEW_COMMANDS      Generate Commands for Table View                            .
IF_VIEW_FACTORY_MM             I MAKE_TOGGLE_VIEW              Generate View with Two Alternative Subviews                 .
IF_VIEW_PPF                    I GET_SUBSCR                    Delivers Report ID and Subscreen for Runtime Environment    .
IF_VIEW_PPF                    I PUBLISH                       Sets the Corresponding Model                                .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_ERROR_STORE      I ADD_MESSAGE                   Save New Message                                            .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CHECK                         Check Virtual Interface                                     .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CHECK_STANDARD_SUBSCREEN      Check Input Data on Default Screen                          .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CHECK_SUBSCREEN1              Check Data in Subscreen1                                    .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CHECK_SUBSCREEN2              Check Data in Subscreen2                                    .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CLOSE                         Quit Plug-In                                                .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I CREATE                        Generate Virtual Interface                                  .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I F4_HELP                       Call F4 Help (Only Where NEED_OWN_DIALOG Does Not Equal "X").
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_CROSS_REFERENCE_DATA      Read Entries for Where-Used List                            .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_DEFAULT_SRV_DEF_STARTPT   Return Default Service Definition Starting Point            .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_MAX_NUMBER_OF_SD_VARIANTS How Many Variants Are Permitted per Service Definition?     .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_MAX_NUMBER_OF_SERVICE_DEFSHow Many Service Definitions Are Allowed per Starting Point?.
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_OBJ_SHORTTEXT             Return Short Text for Object Reference (Properties Tab)     .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_ORIGINAL_FOR_FUNCTION     Returns Original Object for VI Function                     .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_SERVICE_DEF_STARTPOINT    Return Service Def. Starting Pt (I=Inside-Out O=Outside-In) .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_SUBSCREEN1_DATA           Get Data from Subscreen1                                    .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I GET_SUBSCREEN2_DATA           Get Data from Subscreen2                                    .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I INIT                          Initialization                                              .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I INITIALIZE_SUBSCREEN1         Initialize Subscreen1                                       .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I INITIALIZE_SUBSCREEN2         Initialize Subscreen2                                       .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I LOAD_ORIGINAL                 Read Original Interface                                     .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I LOAD_ORIGINAL_DESCRIPTION     Read Original Description                                   .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I MAY_SD_VARIANTS_BE_CHANGED    Can Service Definition Variants Be Changed?                 .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I MODIFY_ALLOWED                Can Subobjects of VI be Supplemented or Deleted?            .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I MODIFY_VIF                    Supplement or Delete Subobjects of VI                       .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I NAVIGATE                      Navigate from VI to Object                                  .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I NEED_OWN_DIALOG               Do you need to use your own selection dialog?               .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I PAI_SPECIAL_SUPPORT           PAI Support for special VIs                                 .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I PBO_SPECIAL_SUPPORT           PBO Support for special VIs                                 .
IF_VIF_PLUGIN_OBJECT           I SPECIAL_SUPPORT               Support for special VIs                                     .
IF_VINFO_PUSH                  I INFO_PUSH                     Send Information to Operational Systems                     .
IF_VI_REFERENCE_OBJECT         I CHECK                         Checks Validity of Definition                               .
IF_VI_REFERENCE_OBJECT         I GET_FUNCTIONS                 Reads Associated Functions for Reference Object             .
IF_VI_REFERENCE_OBJECT         I GET_PARAMETERS                Reads Associated Parameters                                 .
IF_VI_REFERENCE_OBJECT         I GET_SHORT_DESCRIPTION         Reads Descriptions for Function                             .
IF_VMCADMIN_DETAIL_INFO        I GET_ACTIVE_VIEW               Returns the properties of the active detail view            .
IF_VMCADMIN_FCODE_LISTENER     I PROCESS_USER_COMMAND          Processes the specified function code                       .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVCONTEXT         I IS_CONTEXT_CACHEABLE          Tells the application whether it should cache the context   .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVCONTEXT         I REFRESH                       Refresh Displayed Content                                   .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVIGATION_OBJECT  I GET_ADDITIONAL_NAV_CONTEXT    May provide additional context menu under navigation node   .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVIGATION_OBJECT  I GET_CONTAINER                 Returns the parent container (if set)                       .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVIGATION_OBJECT  I GET_GUI_CONTROL               Returns the direct child of the application container       .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVIGATION_OBJECT  I HANDLE_CONTEXT_MENU_SELECT    Handles own context menu selections                         .
IF_VMCADMIN_NAVIGATION_OBJECT  I SET_CONTAINER                 Links internal model to the external parent container       .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVDR_REGISTRY I CALL_PROVIDER                 Goes to the provider specified                              .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVDR_REGISTRY I GET_CAPABLE_PROVIDERS         Returns provider that can display the session specified     .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVDR_REGISTRY I GET_PROVIDERS                 Returns provider of a request type                          .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVDR_REGISTRY I REGISTER_PROVIDER             Registers a provider to display the specified request types .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVIDER        I REGISTER                      Registers this provider                                     .
IF_VMC_PRF_DET_PROVIDER        I SHOW_DETAILS                  Displays details of specified request                       .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I CAN_DISPLAY                   Can display the given profiling session in evaluation module.
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I CLOSE_SESSION                 Closes the open session and releases resources              .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I GET_GUI_CONTROL               Provides the GUI control used for displaying                .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I GET_NAME                      Provides the name of this evaluation module                 .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I GET_SUBSCREEN_NR              Provides the number of an (optional) subscreen              .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I OPEN_SESSION                  Opens the saved profiling run in specified directory        .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I SET_CONTAINER                 Sets the container in which the UI is displayed             .
IF_VMC_PRF_EVALUATION_MODULE   I SET_DETAILS_PROVIDER_REGISTRY Transfers the registry for details provider                 .
IF_VRS_TABLE_COMPARE           I GET_DETAILS                   Gets Details on Table Differences                           .
IF_VRS_TABLE_COMPARE           I GET_SUMMARY                   Gets Summary of Differences Between Tables                  .
IF_VRS_TABLE_COMPARE           I GET_TABLE_INFO                Gets Organizational Data of Tables                          .
IF_VSCAN_INSTANCE              I SCAN_BYTES                    Scan a byte sequence                                        .
IF_VSCAN_INSTANCE              I SCAN_FILE                     Scanning of a Local (Application Server) File               .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I CREATE_NEW                    Display New Flow Logic                                      .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I GET_FLOWLOGIC                 Get Flow Logic                                              .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I GET_NAME                      Get Name                                                    .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I GET_SOURCE                    Get source code                                             .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I LOAD                          Load Flow Logic                                             .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All Templates in Service                               .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I PUBLISH                       Publish Flow Logic                                          .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I SET_FLOWLOGIC                 Set Flow Logic                                              .
IF_W3_API_FLOW_LOGIC           I SET_SOURCE                    Set Source                                                  .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I CREATE_NEW                    Create new JavaScript file                                  .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I GET_NAME                      Get JavaScript name                                         .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I GET_SOURCE                    Get JavaScript source                                       .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I LOAD                          Load JavaScript file                                        .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load all JavaScript files of a service                      .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I PUBLISH                       Publish a JavaScript file                                   .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_JAVASCRIPT           I SET_SOURCE                    Set JavaScript source                                       .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I CREATE_NEW                    Create New MIME                                             .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I GET_NAME                      Get MIME Name                                               .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I GET_SOURCE                    Get MIME Source                                             .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I LOAD                          Load MIME                                                   .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All MIMEs in Service                                   .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I PUBLISH                       Publish MIME                                                .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_MIME                 I SET_SOURCE                    Set MIME Source                                             .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I CREATE_NEW                    Create New MIME                                             .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I GET_NAME                      Get MIME Name                                               .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I GET_SOURCE                    Get MIME Source                                             .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I LOAD                          Load MIME                                                   .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All MIMEs in Service                                   .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I PUBLISH                       Publish MIME                                                .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_MIME_LANG            I SET_SOURCE                    Set MIME Source                                             .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I CHECK_EXIST                   Existence check                                             .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I CREATE_NEW                    Create                                                      .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get MiniApp Attributes                                      .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I GET_NAME                      Return MiniApp Name                                         .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I GET_PARAMETERS                Get MiniApp Parameters                                      .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I GET_SERVICE_INTERFACE_PARAM   Insert Service Interface Parameter                          .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I LOAD                          Read                                                        .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set MiniApp Attributes                                      .
IF_W3_API_MINIAPP              I SET_PARAMETERS                Set MiniApp Parameters                                      .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I COPY                          Copy Object                                                 .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I DELETE                        Delete Object                                               .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I DELETE_FROM_BUFFER            Delete Object from Buffer                                   .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I GET_CHANGEABLE                Query: Can Object Be Changed?                               .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I GET_CHANGED                   Unsaved Changes                                             .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I GET_FULL_NAME                 Return Complete Name                                        .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I GET_PUBLISHED                 Query Publishing Status of Object                           .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I GET_TRANSPORT_TYPE            Return Transport Object Type                                .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I PUBLISH                       Publish Object on ITS                                       .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I PUBLISH_LOCAL                 Publish Object in Local Directory                           .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I REFRESH_DEVCLASS              Read Package Again                                          .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I SAVE                          Save Object                                                 .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I SET_CHANGEABLE                Set Mode to Display or Change                               .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I SET_PUBLISH_INFO              Sets Publishing Status                                      .
IF_W3_API_OBJECT               I UNDO_CHANGES                  Undo Changes                                                .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I CREATE_NEW                    Create New Resource File                                    .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_JAVASCRIPT                Returns all JavaScript Files for Theme                      .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_MIMES                     Returns All MIMEs on Topic                                  .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_MIMES_LANG                Returns All Language-Dependent MIMEs on Topic               .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_NAME                      Get Resource Name                                           .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_PARAMETERS                Get Resource Parameters                                     .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_TEMPLATES                 Returns All Templates on Topic                              .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I GET_TEMPLATES_LANG            Returns All Language-Dependent Templates on Topic           .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I LOAD                          Load Resource File                                          .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All Resource Files for a Service                       .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I PUBLISH                       Publish Resource File                                       .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_RESOURCE             I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Resource Parameters                                     .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I CREATE_NEW                    Create New Service                                          .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_FLOWS                     Returns all Templates with Flow Logic for Service           .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_INTERFACE_PARAMETERS      Get Service Interface Parameters                            .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_JAVASCRIPTS               Returns all JavaScript Files for Service                    .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_MIMES                     Returns All MIMEs for a Service                             .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_MIMES_LANG                Returns All Language-Dependent MIMEs for a Service          .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_NAME                      Get Service Name                                            .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_PARAMETERS                Get Service Parameters                                      .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_RESOURCES                 Returns All Resource Files for a Service                    .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_TEMPLATES                 Returns All Templates for Service                           .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_TEMPLATES_LANG            Returns All Language-Dependent Templates for a Service      .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I GET_TRANSACTION               Returns All Transactions Entered as Parameters for Service  .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I LOAD                          Load Service                                                .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I PUBLISH                       Publish Service                                             .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I SET_INTERFACE_PARAMETERS      Set Service Interface Parameters                            .
IF_W3_API_SERVICE              I SET_PARAMETERS                Set Service Parameters                                      .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I CREATE_NEW                    Create New Template                                         .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I GET_FLOWLOGIC                 Get Flow Logic                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I GET_NAME                      Get Template Name                                           .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I GET_SOURCE                    Get Template Source                                         .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I LOAD                          Load Template                                               .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All Templates in Service                               .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I PUBLISH                       Publish Template                                            .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I SET_FLOWLOGIC                 Set Flow Logic                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE             I SET_SOURCE                    Set Template Source                                         .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I CREATE_NEW                    Create New Template                                         .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Get attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I GET_NAME                      Get Template Name                                           .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I GET_SOURCE                    Get Template Source                                         .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I LOAD                          Load Template                                               .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I LOAD_ALL_IN_SERVICE           Load All Templates for a Service                            .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I PUBLISH                       Publish Template                                            .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I SET_ATTRIBUTES                Set Attributes                                              .
IF_W3_API_TEMPLATE_LANG        I SET_SOURCE                    Set Template Source                                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_CONVERTER_NODE            Create New Converter Node                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_DEFAULT_NODE              Create New Default Node                                     .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_EVENT_NODE                Creates a New Node for an Event and Inserts it as a Subnode .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_EXCEPTION_NODE            Create New Exception Node                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_FILEMAP_NODE              Create New Filemapping Node                                 .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_MAPPING_NODE              Create New Mapping Node                                     .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_MODULE_NODE               Create New Module Node                                      .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_PERSISTENT_NODE           Creates a New PERSISTENT Node                               .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_RESULT_NODE               Creates a New RESULT Node                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I ADD_STATE_NODE                Creates a New STATE Node                                    .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Read Element Attribute                                      .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_BOOLE_VALUE               Returns Value of Type Boolean                               .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_CHILD                     Returns the Subnode with the Given name; or NULL            .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_ENUM_VALUE                Returns Property Value of Type enum                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_FIRST_CHILD               Returns the First Subordinate Node                          .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_HANDLER                   Returns Name of Event Handler                               .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_ICON_VALUE                Returns Property Value of Type Icon                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_INT_VALUE                 Returns Property Value of Type Integer                      .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_LAST_CHILD                Returns Last Subnode                                        .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_NAME                      Returns Property Name                                       .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_NEXT                      returns Next Same-Level Node to This Node                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_NEXT_STATE                Returns Property NEXT_STATE                                 .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_NEXT_TEMPLATE             Returns Property NEXT_TEMPLATE                              .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_NODE_TYPE                 Returns Enumerated Values for the Various Node Types        .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_PARENT                    Returns Superior Node                                       .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_PREVIOUS                  Returns the Previous Same-Level Node to This Node           .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_STATEFUL                  Returns the Attribute STATEFUL                              .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_STRING_VALUE              Returns Property Value of Type String                       .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_SUBTYPE                   Returns Name of an ENUM Type                                .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_TEXT_VALUE                Returns Property Value of Type Text                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_TYPE                      Returns Property Type (BOOLE, INT, etc.)                    .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I GET_VALUE                     Gets Property Value of Given Type                           .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I IS_LEAF                       Returns TRUE if Node Has no Subnodes                        .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I IS_PROP_READ_ONLY             True if Value of Property with Given Name Cannot Be Changed .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I IS_READ_ONLY                  Returns True if Node Value Cannot Be Changed                .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I REMOVE                        Deletes a Node and All Its Subnodes                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Set Any Element Attribute                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_BOOLE_VALUE               Sets Property Value of Type Boolean                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_CLASS                     Sets Class Attribute                                        .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_COMMENT                   Sets Comment Attribute                                      .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_ENUM_VALUE                Sets Property Value of Type Enum                            .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_HANDLER                   Sets Event Handler                                          .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_ICON_VALUE                Sets Property Value of Type Icon                            .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_INT_VALUE                 Sets Property Value of Type Iteger                          .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_NAME                      Sets Property Name                                          .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_NEXT_STATE                Sets Attribute NEXT_STATE                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_NEXT_TEMPLATE             Sets Attribute NEXT_TEMPLATE                                .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_NODE_TYPE                 Sets Values for the Various Node Types                      .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_OR_REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE       Set/Remove Element Attribute                                .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_READ_ONLY                 Sets Property Value to Read-Only or Read/Write              .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_STRING_VALUE              Sets Property Value of Type String                          .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_SUBTYPE                   Sets Name of an ENUM Type                                   .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_TEXT_VALUE                Sets Property Value of Type Text                            .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_TYPE                      Sets TYPE Attribute                                         .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE            I SET_VALUE                     Sets Property Value of Given Type                           .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I FIND                          Find Node of Given Type and Optionally Name                 .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_ATTR                  Get Named Attribute of Associated DOM Node                  .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_ATTRS                 Get Attributes of Associated DOM Node                       .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_NAME                  Get Name of Associated DOM Node                             .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_NODE                  Get Associated DOM Node                                     .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_TEXT                  Get Text of Associated DOM Node                             .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I GET_DOM_TYPE                  Get Type of Associated DOM Node                             .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I REMOVE_DOM_ATTR               Delete Attribute                                            .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I SET_DOM_ATTR                  Set Named Attribute of Associated DOM Node                  .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I SET_DOM_NAME                  Set Name of Associated DOM Node                             .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I SET_DOM_TEXT                  Set Text of Associated DOM Node                             .
IF_W3_FLOW_DOM_TREE_DIAG       I TRANSLATE_ATTR                Translate Attributes to Uppercase                           .
IF_W3_NAVIGATOR                I NAVIGATE                      Create Navigation Request When Double-click Detected        .
IF_W3_NAVIGATOR                I PRESS_F1                      Create Navigation Request When F1 Pressed                   .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_LAST_ROUTING              Result of Last Agent Determination                          .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_RULE_ID                   ID of Rule                                                  .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_RULE_RESULT               Result of Agent Determination                               .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_RULE_TYPE                 Rule Category                                               .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_TASK_ID                   Task ID                                                     .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_WORKFLOW_ID               Workflow ID                                                 .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_WORKITEM_CONTEXT          Work item context                                           .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I GET_WORKITEM_ID               Current Work Item (If New Agent Determination = 'X')        .
IF_WAPI_ROUTING_CONTEXT        I IS_REROUTING                  New Agent Determination Active                              .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I DO_COMMIT_WORK                Register Commit Work                                        .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_DESCRIPTION               Work item description                                       .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_EVT_NAME                  Gets Name of Event                                          .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_HEADER                    Header                                                      .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_PROPERTY                  Value of a Workflow Attribute (Basic Data + Step Data)      .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_RULE_CONTEXT              Delivers the Current Rule Context                           .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_RULE_RESULT               Delivers the Result of the Current Rule Resolution          .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_STATE_TRANSITION          Status transfer                                             .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_TASK_ID                   Name of task                                                .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_TOP_CONTAINER             Container of Top Work Item                                  .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WF_CONTAINER              Workflow Container                                          .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WI_CONTAINER              Work Item Container                                         .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WORKFLOW_ID               Workflow ID                                                 .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WORKFLOW_TASK_ID          Workflow Name                                               .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WORKFLOW_VERSION          Workflow Version                                            .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I GET_WORKITEM_ID               Work item ID                                                .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I IS_ENQUEUED                   Work Item Is Available Exclusively to the Caller            .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I SET_DEBUG                     Activate/Deactivate Debugging                               .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I SET_MESSAGE_TO_LOG            Writes Message to the Work Item Log                         .
IF_WAPI_WORKITEM_CONTEXT       I SET_TRACE                     Switch trace on/off                                         .
IF_WAP_PUSH                    I CANCEL_MESSAGE                Deletes Message in WAP GW That Has Not Been Transferred     .
IF_WAP_PUSH                    I PUSH_CO_MESSAGE               Transfers Push Cache Operation Message to WAP GW            .
IF_WAP_PUSH                    I PUSH_SI_MESSAGE               Transfers Push Cache Indication Message to WAP GW           .
IF_WAP_PUSH                    I PUSH_SL_MESSAGE               Transfers Push Service Load Message to WAP GW               .
IF_WAP_PUSH                    I STATUSQUERY_MESSAGE           Determines the Status of Push Messages                      .
IF_WB2_ACTION                  I DO                            Execute Action                                              .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I BADI                          BADI Call                                                   .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I FREE                          Delete Data Tables                                          .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_DOC                       Return Objects for Selected Lines                           .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_KEYINFO                   Key Information for Fullscreen ALV                          .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_MARK_MODE                 Selection mode (several, single, no lines)                  .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_SELECTION_TYPE            Type of Selection (Header, Item, Both)                      .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_TABLE                     Data Table for ALV Display                                  .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_VARIANT                   Key for Variant Storage                                     .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I GET_VARIANT_FULL_SCREEN       Key for Variant Storage Fullscreen                          .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I IS_DUMMY                      Dummy Object Only?                                          .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I IS_LEADER_CHOOSEABLE          Can Leading Header Be Selected?                             .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I SET_LEADER_IS_CHOOSEABLE      Leading Header can be Selected                              .
IF_WB2_ALV_DATA                I SET_NEW_LEADER                Set New Leading Header                                      .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I DISPLAY                       Display Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I FREE                          Remove Control                                              .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I FULL_SCREEN                   Double-Line ALV in Full Screen                              .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I GET_ALV_GRID                  ALV Grid Control                                            .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I GET_SELECTED                  Lines Selected in ALV                                       .
IF_WB2_ALV_VIEW                I REFRESH_TABLE_DISPLAY         Refresh display                                             .
IF_WB2_ASSO_CHECK              I CHECK                         Execute Action                                              .
IF_WB2_BAPI_ENHANCE            I AT_CHANGE                     Enrich BAPI Data Before Changing Business Process Logic     .
IF_WB2_BAPI_ENHANCE            I AT_CREATE                     Enrich BAPI Data Before Creating Business Process Logic     .
IF_WB2_BAPI_ENHANCE            I GET_EXTENSIONS                Provide Additional Data in BSPI Extension                   .
IF_WB2_BAPI_ENHANCE            I SET_EXTENSIONS                Copy Additional Data From BAPI Extension                    .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I AT_ITEM_DELETION              Carry Out Deletion of an Item                               .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I AT_READ                       Prepare Data After Reading                                  .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_AT_UPDATE              Prepare Data for Saving                                     .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_BEFORE_UPDATE          Adjust Data Before Saving                                   .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_BUSINESS_DATA          Change Business Data                                        .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_HEADER_DATA            Change Header Data                                          .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_ITEM_DATA              Change Item Data                                            .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_PRICING_HEADER         Extend Communication Structure KOMK                         .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_PRICING_ITEM           Extend Communication Structure KOMP                         .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHANGE_SCHEDULE_DATA          Change Schedule Lines                                       .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_BEFORE_UPDATE           Last Checks for Saving                                      .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_BUSINESS_DATA           Check Business Data                                         .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_DELETE_TC_ITEM          Check Deletion of an Item                                   .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_HEADER_DATA             Check Header Data                                           .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_ITEM_DATA               Check Item Data                                             .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_RELEASE_MM              Check if Repeat Release is Necessary - MM Side              .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_RELEASE_SD              Check if Repeat Release is Necessary - SD Side              .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I CHECK_SCHEDULE_DATA           Check Schedule Lines                                        .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I DATALOSS_CHECK                Check Loss of Data                                          .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I DELETION_CHECK                Check if Document Can Be Deleted                            .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I NUMBER_CHANGE                 Switch Document Numbers                                     .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I REFRESH                       Reset Data                                                  .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I SAVE_CHECK                    Check Save                                                  .
IF_WB2_BL_ENHANCEMENTS         I SWU_OBJECT_PUBLISH            Publish Business Object                                     .
IF_WB2_CHECK                   I CHECK                         Execute action                                              .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_COPY                      Copy Formula Pricing                                        .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_COPY_FOLLOW_ON            Copy Formula Pricing in Follow-On Document                  .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_DELETE                    Delete Formula Pricing                                      .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_INIT                      Reset Formula Pricing                                       .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_NUMBER_CHANGE             Number Exchange for Formula Pricing                         .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_READ                      Read Formula Pricing                                        .
IF_WB2_CPE_BD                  I CPE_SAVE                      Save Formula Pricing                                        .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM               I IS_DUMMY                      Dummy Class Only                                            .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_AC            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_ADDONZ1       I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_ADDONZ2       I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_ADDONZ3       I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_AGENCY        I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_AGENCY_LIST   I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_DELIVERY      I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_IV            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_MD            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_PO            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_SI            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_SI_LST        I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_SO            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DATA_FROM_TC            I ADD                           Add Data of a Document                                      .
IF_WB2_DETERMINE_STEP          I GET_STEP                      Business Process Step                                       .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I ARE_ALL_FOLLOW_ITEMS_DEL      Are all subsequent items in "i_doc" deleted?                .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I CALC_ITEM                     Generate Item Object from Item Key                          .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I CONVERT_ITEM_KEY              Item Key from Association in TEW Format                     .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I DEQUEUE_WBGT                  Unlock WBGT Entry for this Document                         .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I DISPLAY                       Call Display Transaction                                    .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I ENQUEUE_WBGT                  Lock WBGT Entry for this Document                           .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_ASSOCIATED_DOC            Determine Documents Linked By Association                   .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_DATA                      Get Data                                                    .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_EMPTY_ALV_DATA            Create Empty Data Object (to Match Document Category)       .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_EMPTY_DATA_CONTAINER      Create Empty Data Container                                 .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_EMPTY_SOURCE_DATA         Create Empty Source Data Object (to Match Document Category).
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_FATHER_ITEM               Parent Item of Item                                         .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_ITEM_2_ITEM_POINTER       Line to Line Pointer for Specified Follow-On Document       .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_KEY                       Document Key                                                .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_LEVEL                     Level in Tree                                               .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_NUM                       Document Number (Independent of Document Category)          .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_RANGE                     Selection Range                                             .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SCENARIO                  Business Scenario                                           .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SELECTION_VIEW            Selection Tool                                              .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SIDE                      Sales or Purchasing Side                                    .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SUCCESSOR                 Follow-On Document in Document Flow                         .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SUCCESSOR_ITEM_REF        Reference to Table of Subsequent Items                      .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SUCCESSOR_NUM             Number of Successors                                        .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SUCC_DOC_ITER             Iterator for Follow-On Documents                            .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_SUCC_ITEM_ITER            Iterator for Subsequent Items                               .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_TEXT                      Descriptive Text with Document Number and Document Category .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I GET_TYPE                      Document Type                                               .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I HAS_VISIBLE_SUCCESSOR         Does Visible Follow-On Doc. Exist for Document Flow Display?.
IF_WB2_DOC                     I IS_DELETED                    Document Deleted?                                           .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I IS_DIRECT_PREDECESSOR         Does This Directly Preceed the Transferred Document?        .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I IS_FLOW_READ                  Was Document Flow Already Read?                             .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I IS_ITEM_DELETED               Document Item Deleted?                                      .
IF_WB2_DOC                     I RESET_FLOW                    Reset Document Flow                                         .
IF_WB2_DOC_ITER                I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Document                                            .
IF_WB2_DOC_ITER                I FIRST                         Set to First Element                                        .
IF_WB2_DOC_ITER                I IS_DONE                       Finished?                                                   .
IF_WB2_DOC_ITER                I NEXT                          Request Next Element                                        .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_AC         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_ADDONZ1    I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_ADDONZ2    I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_ADDONZ3    I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_AGENCY     I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_AGENCY_LST I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_DELIVERY   I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_IV         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_MD         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_PO         I ENHANCE                       Enhance                                                     .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_SI         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_SI_LST     I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_SO         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ENHANCE_DATA_TC         I ENHANCE                       Enhance Data                                                .
IF_WB2_ITEM_ITER               I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Document                                            .
IF_WB2_ITEM_ITER               I FIRST                         Set to First Element                                        .
IF_WB2_ITEM_ITER               I IS_VALID                      Valid Value?                                                .
IF_WB2_ITEM_ITER               I NEXT                          Request Next Element                                        .
IF_WB2_OBSERVER                I GET_HANDLE                    Handle                                                      .
IF_WB2_OBSERVER                I UPDATE                        Update                                                      .
IF_WB2_PARA_FOR_DATA_LIST      I GET_PARA                      Variant and Selection Categ. for Data List                  .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS_DOCUMENT Change Tab Control Label                                    .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS_HEADER   Change Tab Control Label                                    .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I CHANGE_TAXI_CAPTIONS_ITEM     Change Tab Control Label                                    .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I GET_FCODE                     Get Function Code                                           .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I RESET_INACTIVE_TABSTRIBS      Tab Is Important for Document Processing                    .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I SET_DOCUMENT_DATA             Transfer Header Data for Additional Screen                  .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I SET_FCODE                     Set Function Code                                           .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I SET_HEADER_DATA               Transfer Header Data for Additional Screen                  .
IF_WB2_SCREEN_ENHANCEMENTS     I SET_ITEM_DATA                 Transfer Item Data for Additional Screen                    .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I GET_SCREEN                    Screen and Program of Selection Screen                      .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I IS_DUMMY                      Dummy Implementation                                        .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I PBO                           Must be Called at PBO Time                                  .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I SET_INTO_ACC_MODE             Set To Talking Software Mode                                .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I TRANSFER_FCODE                Transfer Function Code (Before Subscreen Call in PAI)       .
IF_WB2_SELECTION_VIEW          I TRANSFER_RANGES               Transfer Ranges to Range Object                             .
IF_WB2_SET_EVENT_CONTAINER     I FILL_EVENT_CONTAINER          Fill Container for Events                                   .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I CALC_EXCLUDING_LIST           Exclusion List for Function Codes                           .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I COLLAPSE                      Compress Screen                                             .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I EXPAND                        Expand Screen                                               .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I GET_PFSTAT                    Return Status                                               .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I GET_SCREEN                    Screen and Program Name                                     .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I IS_COLLAPSED                  Compressed Screen?                                          .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I IS_EMPTY                      Empty Screen?                                               .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I IS_VISIBLE                    Is View Visible?                                            .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I PBO                           Must be Called in PBO                                       .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I SET_VISIBLE                   Make this View Visible                                      .
IF_WB2_SUBSCREEN               I TRANSFER_FCODE                Distribute FCode (Before Subscreen Call in PAI)             .
IF_WB2_TEW_TITLE_BADI          I GET_TITLE                     Return Title                                                .
IF_WB2_TEW_VBD_FOLDER_TEXT_BD  I GET_TEXT                      Description Text for Folder                                 .
IF_WB2_TRANSFER                I IS_DISPLAY_ONLY               Only Display Data                                           .
IF_WB2_TRANSFER                I SAVE                          Store Data                                                  .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I FREE                          Release Resources                                           .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I GET_BUTTON                    Pushbutton List                                             .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I GET_FRAME_TEXT                Outline Text                                                .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I GET_SCREEN                    Screen and Program Name                                     .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I INIT                          Transfer data                                               .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I IS_DUMMY                      Dummy Object Only?                                          .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I PBO                           Must be Called in PBO                                       .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I READY_FOR_SAVE                Ready for saving?                                           .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I READY_FOR_TRANSFER            Ready for data transfer?                                    .
IF_WB2_VISUAL_COMPONENT        I SET_INTO_ACC_MODE             Set To Talking Software Mode                                .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I ACTIVATE                      Activate                                                    .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I CREATE                        Create                                                      .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I DEACTIVATE                    Deactivate                                                  .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I DELETE                        Delete                                                      .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I DELETEND                      Delete                                                      .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I DISPLAY                       Display                                                     .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I EDIT                          Editing                                                     .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I EDITCREATE                    Edit or Create                                              .
IF_WB_BB_GENERIC_FUNCTIONS     I RENAME                        Rename                                                      .
IF_WB_BROWSER_SELECTION        I CREATE_INSTANCE               Get Instance for Browser Parametrization                    .
IF_WB_BROWSER_SELECTION        I DESTRUCT                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_WB_BROWSER_SELECTION        I GET_NAME_DEFAULT              Set Default for Name                                        .
IF_WB_BROWSER_SELECTION        I SHOW_SELECTION                Set Browser Parameterization                                .
IF_WB_CONTROL_TOOL             I SET_ACTIVE_SCREEN             Link Controls to Current Screen: Obsolete                   .
IF_WB_CONTROL_TOOL_EXTENDED_1  I GET_TOOL_NAME                 Returns the tool names (for window title)                   .
IF_WB_CUE_CARD                 I GET                           Read Cue Card                                               .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I ACTIVATE                      Activates                                                   .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I ACTIVATE_ENHANCEMENTS         Activate Enhancement                                        .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I CHECK                         Checks                                                      .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I EDIT_ENHANCEMENTS             Edit Enhancements                                           .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I GET                           Get Source and Editor Reference                             .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I READ                          Reads from the database                                     .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I SAVE                          Saves                                                       .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I SAVE_ENHANCEMENTS             Save Enhancements                                           .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I SET                           Set Source and Editor Reference                             .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I TOGGLE_ACTIVE_INACTIVE        Toggle Active/Inactive                                      .
IF_WB_DARK_FUNCTIONALITY       I TOGGLE_DISPLAY_EDIT           Toggle Display/Edit                                         .
IF_WB_DECISION_CLASS           I GET_TOOL_FOR_REQUEST          Determine Tool For Request                                  .
IF_WB_DECISION_CLASS           I GET_TOOL_FROM_TOOL_ACCESS     Generate Request from Parameters of RS_TOOL_ACCESS          .
IF_WB_EDITABLE_OBJECT          I DELETE_OBJECT                 Set object to deleted                                       .
IF_WB_EDITABLE_OBJECT          I SAVE_OBJECT                   Save object                                                 .
IF_WB_EDITABLE_OBJECT          I SET_CHANGEABLE                Toggle Object Change/Display                                .
IF_WB_EDITABLE_OBJECT          I UNDO_CHANGES                  Undo changes                                                .
IF_WB_ENHBROWSER_VIS           I DESTRUCT                      Destroy Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_ENHBROWSER_VIS           I GET_SELECTED_NODES            IDs that Fill Selected Nodes in the Control Tree            .
IF_WB_ENHBROWSER_VIS           I GET_TREE_STATE                Read State of Tree                                          .
IF_WB_ENHBROWSER_VIS           I REFRESH                       Update Visualization                                        .
IF_WB_ENHBROWSER_VIS           I SHOW                          Display Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_LAYOUT_MANAGER           I GET_DEFAULT_TOOL_LAYOUT       Get Default Window Layout for Tool                          .
IF_WB_LAYOUT_MANAGER           I GET_NEW_WINDOW_STYLE          Get Window Layout for Tool Display                          .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I CONTROL_PAI                   Callback for Tools in PAI Event                             .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I CONTROL_PBO                   Callback for Tools in PBO Event                             .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I CREATE_SECONDARY_WINDOW       Create Secondary Window for Tool                            .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I DEACTIVATE                    Prepare WB Manager for Navigation                           .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I DELETE_SECONDARY_WINDOW       Delete Secondary Window for Tool                            .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I GET_NAVIGATION_CONTEXT        Read Navigation Context                                     .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I GET_STATUS                    Get All Manager Functions                                   .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I GET_TOOL_RESOLUTION_AGENT     Read Registry Reference                                     .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I GET_WINDOW                    Read Reference to Window                                    .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I PROCESS_BACK                  Navigation 'Back'                                           .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I PROCESS_FORWARD               Navigation 'Forward'                                        .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I REQUEST_TOOL_ACCESS           Process Workbench Request                                   .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I SET_NAVIGATION_CONTEXT        Set Navigation Context                                      .
IF_WB_MANAGER                  I SET_WORKSPACE                 Set Workspace                                               .
IF_WB_MIME_SELECTION           I CREATE_INSTANCE               Get Instance for Browser Parametrization                    .
IF_WB_MIME_SELECTION           I DESTRUCT                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_WB_MIME_SELECTION           I SHOW_SELECTION                Set Browser Parameterization                                .
IF_WB_OBJECT_STATE             I GET_DESCRIPTION               Return State Description                                    .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I GET_CURRENT_WB_OBJECT_STATE   Get Current Object View from Tool                           .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I GET_ENQUEUE_OBJECT            Get Lock Object for Logical Object Type                     .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I GET_REQUEST_FROM_TOOL_ACCESS  Generate Request from Parameters of RS_TOOL_ACCESS          .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I GET_RESTORE_WB_PROGRAM_STATE  Get the Current Status of a Workbench Program               .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I GET_RESTORE_WB_REQUEST        Get a Workbench Request for Restore                         .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I PREPARE_FOR_REINVOCATION      Preparation - Internal Navigation                           .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I PREPARE_FOR_TERMINATION       Logical End for a Program (Save, Destroy....)               .
IF_WB_PROGRAM                  I PROCESS_WB_REQUEST            Processing for a Workbench Request                          .
IF_WB_PROGRAM_EXTENDED_1       I COMPLETE_REQUEST_EXECUTION    Complete Request Processing in Active Tool                  .
IF_WB_PROGRAM_EXTENDED_1       I PREPARE_REQUEST_EXECUTION     Prepare Request Processing in Active Tool                   .
IF_WB_REPBROWSER_VIS           I DESTRUCT                      Destroy Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_REPBROWSER_VIS           I GET_SELECTED_NODES            IDs that Fill Selected Nodes in the Control Tree            .
IF_WB_REPBROWSER_VIS           I GET_TREE_STATE                Read State of Tree                                          .
IF_WB_REPBROWSER_VIS           I REFRESH                       Update Visualization                                        .
IF_WB_REPBROWSER_VIS           I SHOW                          Display Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_REP_BROWSER_VIS          I DESTRUCT                      Destroy Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_REP_BROWSER_VIS          I GET_SELECTED_NODES            IDs that Fill Selected Nodes in the Control Tree            .
IF_WB_REP_BROWSER_VIS          I GET_TREE_STATE                Read State of Tree                                          .
IF_WB_REP_BROWSER_VIS          I REFRESH                       Update Visualization                                        .
IF_WB_REP_BROWSER_VIS          I SHOW                          Display Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_REQ_BROWSER_VIS          I DESTRUCT                      Destroy Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_REQ_BROWSER_VIS          I GET_TREE_STATE                Read State of Tree                                          .
IF_WB_REQ_BROWSER_VIS          I REFRESH                       Update Visualization                                        .
IF_WB_REQ_BROWSER_VIS          I SHOW                          Display Visualization                                       .
IF_WB_SOURCE_NAVIGATION        I GET_NAVIGATION_OBJECT         Read Navigation Request                                     .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I CALL_WB_PAI                   PAI of WB Control                                           .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I CALL_WB_PBO                   PAI of WB Control                                           .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I CHECK_SAVE                    Informs WB Tool of DB Update                                .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I GET_CONTEXT                   Returns Context                                             .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I GET_TOOL_STACK                Returns Stack                                               .
IF_WB_TOOL_BRF                 I TOOL_ACCESS                   Accesses WB Tool                                            .
IF_WB_TOOL_LAYOUT              I GET_TOOL_LAYOUT               Read Window Layout for Tool                                 .
IF_WB_TOOL_RESOLUTION          I GET_TOOL_FOR_REQUEST          Determine Tool For Request                                  .
IF_WB_TREE_COMPARE             I TC_GET_NODE_DETAILS           Gets Table with Name-Value Pairs                            .
IF_WB_WINDOW                   I GET_WINDOW_STYLE              Return Layout of Window                                     .
IF_WB_WINDOW                   I SET_INVISIBLE                 Make Window Invisible                                       .
IF_WB_WINDOW                   I SET_VISIBLE                   Make Window Visible                                         .
IF_WB_WINDOW                   I SET_WINDOW_TITLE              Set Window Title                                            .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I DESTRUCT                      Destroy Window Manager                                      .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_ACTIVE_WINDOW             Which Window Has the Focus                                  .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_TOOL_LAYOUT               Read Window Layout for Tool                                 .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_WINDOWS_BY_VISIBILITY     Read Window IDs for Visibility                              .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_WINDOW_FOR_TOOL           Get Window For Tool                                         .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_WINDOW_FROM_ID            Read Reference to Window Instance                           .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_WINDOW_ID_FROM_TOOLNAME   get the window ID from a tool name (if present and unique)  .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I GET_WINDOW_WITH_LAYOUT        Create Window With Particular Layout                        .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I RELEASE_WINDOW_FOR_TOOL       Release Tool Window                                         .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I SET_ACTIVE_SCREEN             Link Window to New Screen                                   .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I SET_ACTIVE_WINDOW             Give Window Focus                                           .
IF_WB_WINDOW_MANAGER           I SET_WINDOW_VISIBILITY         Control Visibility of Windows                               .
IF_WCB_ADDRESS                 I CREATE                        Generate New Address                                        .
IF_WCB_APPLICATION             I GET_APPLICATION               Return Application                                          .
IF_WCB_APPLICATION             I GET_CC_FACTORY                Return Condition Contract Factory                           .
IF_WCB_APPLICATION             I GET_CHECK_MANAGER             Return Check Manager                                        .
IF_WCB_BILLING_CONDITIONS_PPF  I CHECK_CONDITIONS_FOR_PPF      Checks Conditions at Start of PPF                           .
IF_WCB_BILLING_VBPA_TO_PPF     I TRANSFORM_VBPA_TO_PPF_PARTNER Transforms Billing Document Partner to Data Suitable for PPF.
IF_WCB_CC                      I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Final Number, Header, Items, Conditions (Without C Lists)   .
IF_WCB_CC                      I CHANGE_NUMBER_CONDITION_LISTS Determine Final Number for Condition Lists                  .
IF_WCB_CC                      I CHECK_CONDITION_BEFORE_SAVE   Conditions: Pre-Save Checks                                 .
IF_WCB_CC                      I CHECK_ELIGIBLE_BEFORE_SAVE    Eligible Partners: Pre-Save Checks                          .
IF_WCB_CC                      I CHECK_HEADER_BEFORE_SAVE      Header: Pre-Save Checks                                     .
IF_WCB_CC                      I DELETE_SINGLE                 Delete Individual Objects (Items, Conditions)               .
IF_WCB_CC                      I GET_CONDITION_LIST_COLL       Return Collection of Condition Lists                        .
IF_WCB_CC                      I GET_ELIGIBLE_LIST             Return List of Eligible Partners                            .
IF_WCB_CC                      I GET_HEADER                    Return Header                                               .
IF_WCB_CC                      I INSERT_COND_TAB_REF           Insert Reference to Condition Tables                        .
IF_WCB_CC                      I LOCK_SINGLE                   Block Individual Objects (Items, Conditions)                .
IF_WCB_CC                      I PERFORM_ACTIVITY              Execute Activity                                            .
IF_WCB_CC                      I PERFORM_ACTIVITY_FOR_ALL      Perform Activity for All Elements in the Document           .
IF_WCB_CC                      I RELEASE_SINGLE                Release Individual Objects (Items, Conditions)              .
IF_WCB_CC                      I SET_DEFAULTING_MODE           Set in Default Mode                                         .
IF_WCB_CC                      I SET_KOMWCOCOI_STAB_REF        Set Reference to Table KOMWCOCOI                            .
IF_WCB_CC                      I USER_STATUS_CHANGE            The User Status was Changed                                 .
IF_WCB_CC_COLL                 I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CC_COLL_RO              I CREATE_ITER_RO                Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I CREATE                        Create a New Condition Contract                             .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I GET_GUID_FOR_NUM              Determine GUID from Document Number                         .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I GET_NUM_FOR_GUID              Determine Document Number from GUID                         .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I PREFETCH                      Read Documents to Buffer                                    .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I PREFETCH_WITH_LOCK            Read Documents with Block to Buffer                         .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I READ_CC                       Read a Condition Contract                                   .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I READ_CCS                      Read Condition Contracts                                    .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I READ_CCS_WITH_LOCK            Read Condition Contracts with Block                         .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I READ_CC_WITH_LOCK             Read a Condition Contract with Block                        .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I RESET                         Reset Factory                                               .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I SET_FROM_ARCHIVE              Construct Document from the Archive                         .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I UNLOCK                        Block a Condition Contract                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_FACTORY              I UPDATE                        Write Data to the Database                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_ITER                 I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CC_ITER_RO              I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_ARCHIVE_AUTHORITY       Check Archiving Authorization                               .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_CHANGE_AUTHORITY        Check Change Authorization                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_COND                    Checks Conditions in a Condition Contract                   .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_ELIGIBLE                Checks a Reliable Partner for a Condition Contract          .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_HEADER                  Checks Condition Contract Header Data                       .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_PRINT_AUTHORITY         Check Print Authorization                                   .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_RELEASE_AUTHORITY       Check Release Authorization                                 .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I CHECK_RELOAD_AUTHORITY        Check Reload Authorization                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_APPLICATION               Return Application                                          .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_CUSTOMIZING               Condition Contract Customizing                              .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_DATE_INTERVAL             Return Validity Interval                                    .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_ELIGIBLE_FOR_GUID         Eligible Partners for GUID                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_GUID                      Return GUID                                                 .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_HEADER_RO                 Header (Read Only)                                          .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_KOMWCOCOF                 Determine Document Flow                                     .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_NUM                       Return Document Number                                      .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I GET_STATUS                    Return Status                                               .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I HAS_ERROR                     has errors                                                  .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_ACTIVE                     Condition Contract Active                                   .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_ACTIVITY_POSSIBLE          Is Activity Possible?                                       .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Can contract be changed?                                    .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_DEFAULTING_MODE            With Default Values                                         .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_DELETED                    Condition Contract Active                                   .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_LOCKED                     Condition Contract Blocked?                                 .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_NEW                        New Document                                                .
IF_WCB_CC_RO                   I IS_READY_FOR_ARCHIVE          Condition Contract Ready for Archiving                      .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK             I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK_COLL        I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK_INT         I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK_INT_COLL    I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK_INT_ITER    I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_CHECK_ITER        I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_COND_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_COND_CHECK_COLL   I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CHAIN_COND_CHECK_ITER   I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_HEAD I CHANGE_HEAD                   Adjust Data Before List Output of Condition Contract Header .
IF_WCB_CHANGE_BEFORE_LIST_ITEM I CHANGE_ITEM                   Adjust Data Before List Output of Condition Contract Item   .
IF_WCB_CHANGE_DET_METHOD       I CHANGE_DET_METHOD             Changes the Determination Method for Condition Contracts    .
IF_WCB_CHANGE_KOMLFKE_PER_ITEM I CHANGE_KOMLFKE                Changes Header Structure for an Item                        .
IF_WCB_CHANGE_KOMLFPE          I CHANGE_KOMLFPE                Changes the Data for an Item                                .
IF_WCB_CHECK_CC_IS_VALID       I IS_COCO_NUM_VALID             Checks if a Designated Condition Contract is Allowed        .
IF_WCB_CHECK_CREATION_VBD      I CHECK_ITEMS_FOR_CREATE_DETAIL Determination Check for Which Item VBDs Are Created         .
IF_WCB_CHECK_CREATION_VBD      I CHECK_ITEMS_FOR_CREATE_GENERALChecks for Which Item VBDs May Be Created                   .
IF_WCB_CHECK_DOC_INDEX         I CHECK_INDEX                   Checks if Document Index is to be Updated                   .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I DEL_COND                      Delete Condition                                            .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I DEL_ELIGIBLE                  Delete Eligible Partner                                     .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_COND_FAILED            Insert Failed Condition Check                               .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_COND_OK                Insert Successful Condition Check                           .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_ELIGIBLE_FAILED        Insert Failed Eligible Partner Check                        .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_ELIGIBLE_OK            Insert Successful Entitled Check                            .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_HEADER_FAILED          Insert Failed Header Check                                  .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I INSERT_HEADER_OK              Insert Successful Header Check                              .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I MERGE_WITH_NEW_LIST           Merge List with Transferred List                            .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST              I REFRESH                       Delete List                                                 .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I GET_COND_ERRORS               Return Error Messages for a Condition                       .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I GET_ELIGIBLE_ERRORS           Return Error Messages for an Eligible Party                 .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I GET_HEADER_ERRORS             Return Error Messages for a Header                          .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I HAS_ERROR                     At least one error?                                         .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I IS_COND_ERROR_FREE            Is One Condition Error-Free?                                .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I IS_COND_FIELD_OK              Is Condition Field Error-Free?                              .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I IS_ELIGIBLE_FIELD_OK          Is Field for Eligible Partner Error-Free?                   .
IF_WCB_CHECK_LIST_RO           I IS_HEADER_FIELD_OK            Is Header Field Error-Free?                                 .
IF_WCB_CHECK_MANAGER           I CHECK_COND                    Checks Conditions in a Condition Contract                   .
IF_WCB_CHECK_MANAGER           I CHECK_ELIGIBLE                Checks a Reliable Partner for a Condition Contract          .
IF_WCB_CHECK_MANAGER           I CHECK_HEADER                  Checks Condition Contract Header Data                       .
IF_WCB_CHECK_PPF_START         I CHECK_PPF_START               Checks If PPF Should Be Started                             .
IF_WCB_COLL                    I DELETE                        Delete Entry                                                .
IF_WCB_COLL                    I INSERT                        Add an Entry                                                .
IF_WCB_COLL                    I INSERT_COLL                   Insert Another Collection                                   .
IF_WCB_COLL                    I RESET                         Delete List                                                 .
IF_WCB_COLL_ITER               I FIRST                         Set to First Entry                                          .
IF_WCB_COLL_ITER               I FREE                          Release Iterator                                            .
IF_WCB_COLL_ITER               I IS_DONE                       completed                                                   .
IF_WCB_COLL_ITER               I NEXT                          Switch to Next Entry                                        .
IF_WCB_COLL_RO                 I GET_SIZE                      Number of Entries                                           .
IF_WCB_COLL_RO                 I IS_CONTAINED                  Is Entry Contained in the List?                             .
IF_WCB_CONDITION               I CHANGE                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION               I CREATE_CONDSCALE              Create scale                                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION               I DELETE                        Delete Condition                                            .
IF_WCB_CONDITION               I DELETE_CONDSCALE              Delete scale                                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_ITER          I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_ITER_RO       I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST          I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Number Exchange                                             .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST          I CREATE_CONDITION              Create Condition                                            .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST          I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST          I FILL_TABLE_WITH_DATA          Enter Condition Data Into Tables                            .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_COLL     I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Number Exchange                                             .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_COLL     I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_COLL_RO  I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Pre-Save Check                                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_COLL_RO  I CREATE_ITER_RO                Create Read Only Iterator                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_COLL_RO  I HAS_ERROR                     has errors                                                  .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_ITER     I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_ITER_RO  I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Pre-Save Check                                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I CREATE_ITER_RO                Create Read Only Iterator                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I FILL_DEFAULT                  Set default values                                          .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I FIND_CONDITIONS               Use Keys to Find Conditions                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_CC_RO                     Return Condition Contract                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_CONDITION_GROUP           Return Condition Group                                      .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_CONDITION_TABLE           Return Condition Table                                      .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_CONDITION_TABLE_NUM       Return Number of Condition Table                            .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_DATE_INTERVAL_HEADER      Return Validity Interval of Header                          .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_HEADER_DATE               Header Date Interval                                        .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_KEY_DESCRIPTION           Text Fields for Key Fields                                  .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_KNUMH_FOR_KOMG            KNUMH from Condition Key                                    .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_KONP_DESCRIPTION          KONP Text Fields                                            .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_STATIC_CONDSCALE_RESTR    Static Restrictions for CONDSCALE                           .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_STATIC_KOMG_RESTR         Static Restrictions for KOMG                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_STATIC_KONH_RESTR         Static Restrictions for KONH                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I GET_STATIC_KONP_RESTR         Static Restrictions for KONP                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I HAS_ERROR                     Errors?                                                     .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I HAS_TOUCHED_SCALE             At Least One Scale was Changed                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I IS_ADD_POSSIBLE               Can a Condition be Added?                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Can Condition List Be Changed?                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I IS_CONDITION_DELETION_POSSIBLEIs Deletion Possible?                                       .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I IS_SCALE_TOUCHED              Was Scale Changed?                                          .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I IS_SUPPORTED                  Is the Table Supported by SAP?                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I TRANSFER_DATA                 Transfer Data                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_LIST_RO       I TRANSFER_REF_TO_CC            Transfer Data References to Condition Contract              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_CONDITION_TYPE            Return Condition Type Object                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_CONDSCALE_RESTRICTION     Restrictions for CONDSCALE                                  .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_CUMULATION_CURRENCY       Currency of Cumulation Fields                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_DATA_DB                   Return Data (DB Version)                                    .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_ERRORS                    Condition Error                                             .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_KOMG_RESTRICTION          Restrictions for KOMG                                       .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_KONH_RESTRICTION          Restrictions for KONH                                       .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_KONP_RESTRICTION          Restrictions for KONP                                       .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_SCALE_BASE_INDICATOR      Scale Basis                                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I GET_SCALE_TYPE                Determine Scale Category                                    .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I HAS_SCALE                     Does at Least One Scale Exist?                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I IS_ERROR_FREE                 Is One Condition Error-Free?                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_RO            I IS_FIELD_OK                   Is Condition Field Error-Free?                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_COLL    I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_COLL_RO I CREATE_ITER_RO                Create Read Only Iterator                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_ITER    I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_ITER_RO I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I DETERMINE_CONDITION_TYPES     Possible Condition Types for Condition Table                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I GET_APPLICATION               Return Application                                          .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I GET_KEYS                      Return Key for Condition Table                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I GET_TABLE_NUM                 Return Table Number                                         .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I GET_TEXT                      Descriptive Text for a Condition Table                      .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I GET_USE                       Provide Usage                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I IS_SALES_TABLE                Condition Table for SD or MM                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TABLE_RO      I IS_SUPPORTED                  Is the Table Supported by SAP?                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_COLL     I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_COLL_RO  I CREATE_ITER_RO                Create Read Only Iterator                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_ITER     I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_ITER_RO  I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_ACCESS                    Return Access Sequence                                      .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_APPLICATION               Application                                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_CALCULATION_RULE          Return Calculation Rule                                     .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_CONDITION_TYPE            Condition Type                                              .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_KZBZG                     Scale Basis                                                 .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_SCALE_CHECKING_RULE       Check Rule for Scale                                        .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_SCALE_TYPE                Scale Type                                                  .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_TEXT                      Description Text of a Condition Type                        .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I GET_USE                       Usage                                                       .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I IS_COCO_FLAG_SET              Read Condition Contract Flag                                .
IF_WCB_CONDITION_TYPE_RO       I IS_COPY_FLAG_SET              Read Copying Flag                                           .
IF_WCB_CONDSCALE_RESTRICTION   I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WCB_COND_TABLE_CHECK        I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_COND_TABLE_CHECK_COLL   I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_COND_TABLE_CHECK_ITER   I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_DETERMINE_CC            I DETERMINE_CC                  Defines a Quantity of Condition Contract Numbers            .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I CHANGE                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I CREATE_PARTNER_ITER           Create Iterator for Partner                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I CREATE_TEXT                   New Text                                                    .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I DELETE                        Delete Eligible Partner                                     .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE                I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_ITER           I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_ITER_RO        I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_ITER_RO        I IS_DONE                       completed                                                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST           I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Number Exchange                                             .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST           I CREATE_ELIGIBLE               Create a New Entry                                          .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST           I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST           I LOCK                          Block Individual Eligible Partners                          .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST           I RELEASE                       Release Individual Eligible Partners                        .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Pre-Save Check                                              .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I CREATE_ITER_RO                Create Read Only Iterator                                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_CC_RO                     Return Condition Contract                                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_DATE_INTERVAL_HEADER      Return Validity Interval of Header                          .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_DESCRIPTION               Mapping to Text Fields                                      .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_ELIGIBLE_FOR_CUSTOMER     Eligible Partners for Customer                              .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_ELIGIBLE_FOR_GUID         Eligible Partners for GUID                                  .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_ELIGIBLE_FOR_LIST         Eligible Partners for Eligible Partner List                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_ELIGIBLE_FOR_VENDOR       Eligible Partners for Vendor                                .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_NUM                       Number of Condition Contract                                .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_SIZE                      Number of Entries                                           .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I GET_STATIC_RESTR              Static Restrictions                                         .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I HAS_ERROR                     has errors                                                  .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_ADD_POSSIBLE               Can an Eligible Partner be Added?                           .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Can Be Changed?                                             .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_COMPLETELY_RELEASED        Release All Entries?                                        .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_ELIGIBLE_DELETION_POSSIBLE Is Deletion Possible?                                       .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_PART_LOCK_POSSIBLE         Partial Block Possible?                                     .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_PART_RELEASE_POSSIBLE      Partial Release Possible?                                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I IS_TEXT_CHANGEABLE            Can Text Be Changed?                                        .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I TRANSFER_DATA                 Transfer Data Tables (Item and Partner)                     .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_LIST_RO        I TRANSFER_KOMWCOCOI_STAB_REF   Set Reference to Table komwcocoi via Callback               .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I CREATE_PARTNER_ITER_RO        Create Iterator for Partner                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_DATA_DB                   Return Data (DB Version)                                    .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_ERRORS                    Error for Eligible Partner                                  .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_HEADER_DATE               Return Header Date Interval                                 .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_TEXT                      Text                                                        .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_TEXT_IDS                  Possible Text Types                                         .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I GET_WCOCOI_RESTRICTION        Restrictions for WCOCOI                                     .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I IS_FIELD_OK                   Is Field for Eligible Partner Error-Free?                   .
IF_WCB_ELIGIBLE_RO             I SELECT_TEXT                   Key for All Existing Texts                                  .
IF_WCB_FIELD_MSG_COLL          I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_FIELD_MSG_COLL          I GET_FIELDS_WITH_MESSAGES      Fields with Errors, Warnings or Information                 .
IF_WCB_FIELD_MSG_COLL          I IS_EQUAL                      Are the Collections Identical?                              .
IF_WCB_FIELD_MSG_ITER          I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_GET_DOCS_FOR_CANCEL     I GET_DOCS_FOR_CANCELLATION     Provides the VBDs That May Be Cancelled                     .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I CHANGE                        Change Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I CHANGE_NUMBER                 Number Exchange                                             .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change text                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I CREATE_PARTNER_ITER           Create Iterator for Partner                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I CREATE_TEXT                   New text                                                    .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I GET_CC                        Return Condition Contract                                   .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I PERFORM_ACTIVITY              Perform Activity                                            .
IF_WCB_HEADER                  I USER_STATUS_CHANGE            The User Status was Changed                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_BADI    I GET_FIELDS                    Fields on Tab Title                                         .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_BADI    I IS_DOUBLE_SPACE_NEEDED        Double Amount of Space Required?                            .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_BADI    I PAI                           After Output                                                .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_BADI    I PBO                           Before Output                                               .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_BADI    I SET_FIELD_MODIFICATOR         Transfer Object That Adjusts Output Attribute               .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I GET_FIELDS                    Fields on Tab Title                                         .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I GET_PROGRAM                   ABAP program                                                .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I GET_SCREEN                    Screen number                                               .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I GET_TEXT                      Text for Tab Title                                          .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I IS_DOUBLE_SPACE_NEEDED        Double Amount of Space Required?                            .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I PAI                           After Output                                                .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I PBO                           Before Output                                               .
IF_WCB_HEADER_DATA_TAB_I_BADI  I SET_FIELD_MODIFICATOR         Transfer Object That Adjusts Output Attribute               .
IF_WCB_HEADER_FIELD_MODIFY     I MODIFY_FIELDS                 Change Attributes of Output Fields                          .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I CHECK_BEFORE_SAVE             Pre-Save Check                                              .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I CREATE_PARTNER_ITER_RO        Create Iterator for Partner                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_CC_RO                     Condition Contract                                          .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_CHANGEDOCUMENT            Read Change Documents                                       .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_COMPANY_CODE              Return Company Code                                         .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_CUSTOMIZING               Return Condition Contract Customizing                       .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_DATA_DB                   Return DB Data                                              .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_DATE_INTERVAL             Return Validity Interval                                    .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_ERRORS                    Header Error                                                .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_GUID                      Return Condition Contract GUID                              .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_NUM                       Return Document Number                                      .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_STATIC_WCOCOH_RESTR       Static Restrictions for WCOCOH                              .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_TEXT                      Header Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_TEXT_IDS                  Possible Text Types                                         .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I GET_WCOCOH_RESTRICTION        Restrictions for WCOCOH                                     .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I HAS_ERROR                     has errors                                                  .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Changeable                                                  .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I IS_DEACTIVATED                Deactivated                                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I IS_FIELD_OK                   Is Header Field Error-Free?                                 .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I SELECT_TEXT                   Key for All Existing Texts                                  .
IF_WCB_HEADER_RO               I TRANSFER_DATA                 Transfer Data                                               .
IF_WCB_KONH_RESTRICTION        I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WCB_KONP_RESTRICTION        I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WCB_PARTNER_ITER            I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_PARTNER_ITER_RO         I CURRENT_ITEM_RO               Current Entry (Read Only)                                   .
IF_WCB_PARTNER_RO              I GET_DATA                      Return Data                                                 .
IF_WCB_PARTNER_RO              I GET_DATA_DB                   Return Data (DB Version)                                    .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL               I DELETE                        Delete Entry                                                .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL               I GET_ENTRY_FOR_KEY             Entry for Generic Key                                       .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL               I INSERT                        Add an Entry                                                .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL               I INSERT_COLL                   Insert Another Collection                                   .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL               I RESET                         Delete List                                                 .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL_RO            I GET_SIZE                      Number of Entries                                           .
IF_WCB_PERS_COLL_RO            I IS_CONTAINED                  Is Entry Contained in the List?                             .
IF_WCB_PERS_OBJECT             I GET_KEY                       Generic Key                                                 .
IF_WCB_PROTOCOL_ITEM_ITER      I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_PROTOCOL_ITEM_ITER      I FIRST                         Set to First Entry                                          .
IF_WCB_PROTOCOL_ITEM_ITER      I IS_DONE                       Completed                                                   .
IF_WCB_PROTOCOL_ITEM_ITER      I NEXT                          Switch to Next Entry                                        .
IF_WCB_PURCHASE_DATA_HEAD      I GET_PURCH_DATA_HEAD           Provides Purchasing-Dependent Header Data per Billing Item  .
IF_WCB_REFRESH_IN_PRICING      I REFRESH                       Initialization Type                                         .
IF_WCB_RESTRICTION             I PERFORM_CHECK                 Execute check                                               .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I BEFORE_LEAVE                  Before Exiting Workbench                                    .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I BEFORE_SAVE                   Before Saving                                               .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I CALC_EXCLUDING_LIST           Exclusion List for Function Codes                           .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I COLLAPSE                      Compress Screen                                             .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I EXPAND                        Expand Screen                                               .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I FREE                          Release Controls                                            .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I GET_FCODE_PREFIX              Prefix for All FCodes                                       .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I GET_FIELD_PROPERTY            Return Field Attribute                                      .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I GET_PROGRAM                   ABAP Program: Current Main Program                          .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I GET_SCREEN                    Screen Number                                               .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process Function Code                                       .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I INIT_CONTROLS                 If Necessary Initialize Controls                            .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I INSERT_CHANGED_FIELD          Insert a Changed Field                                      .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I IS_COLLAPSED                  Compressed Screen?                                          .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I IS_DUMMY                      Only Dummy (No Connection to Model)                         .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I IS_EMPTY                      Empty Screen?                                               .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I PAI                           PAI Time                                                    .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I PBO                           PBO Time                                                    .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I PBO_FINISHED                  Called at End of PBO                                        .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I PERFORM_INPUT_CHECKS          Perform Input Checks and Transfer Data                      .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I RELEASE_MODEL_LINK            Delete Reference to Model                                   .
IF_WCB_SCREEN                  I RESET_CHANGED_FIELDS          Reset List of Changed Fields                                .
IF_WCB_STATIC_RESTRICTION      I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK             I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK_COLL        I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK_INT         I CHECK                         Check                                                       .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK_INT_COLL    I CREATE_ITER                   Generate Iterator                                           .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK_INT_ITER    I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_TABLE_CHECK_ITER        I CURRENT_ITEM                  Current Entry                                               .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER           I CHANGE_TEXT                   Change Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER           I CREATE_TEXT                   New Text                                                    .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER           I DELETE_ALL_TEXTS              Delete All Texts from a Context                             .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER           I DELETE_TEXT                   Delete Text                                                 .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER           I UPDATE_TEXT                   Create or Change Texts                                      .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER_RO        I GET_TEXT                      Text                                                        .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER_RO        I GET_TEXT_IDS                  Possible Text Types                                         .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER_RO        I IS_CHANGEABLE                 Can Text Be Changed?                                        .
IF_WCB_TEXT_TRANSFER_RO        I SELECT_TEXT                   Key for All Existing Texts                                  .
IF_WCB_TRANSFER_BILLING        I TRANSFER_DATA_BILLING         Data Transfer for a Customer Billing Document               .
IF_WCB_TRANSFER_SALES          I TRANSFER_DATA_SALES           Data Transfer for a Sales Document                          .
IF_WCB_WCOCOH_RESTRICTION      I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WCB_WCOCOI_RESTRICTION      I INSERT_RESTRICTION            Insert Restriction                                          .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I ATTACH_CONTROLLER             INTERNAL: Do not Use!                                       .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I EXECUTE_ACTION                Execute Action                                              .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I FINISH                        Finish                                                      .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I GET_SERIALIZABLE              XML Serialization                                           .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I START                         Start                                                       .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I START_OVER                    Start Over                                                  .
IF_WDK_BE_CONTROLLER           I TOP_LAST_ACTION               Get Last Action                                             .
IF_WDK_CONSISTENCY_MANAGER     I CHECK                         Check data for consistency                                  .
IF_WDK_CONSISTENCY_MANAGER     I CLEAR                         Clear all buffered data                                     .
IF_WDK_CONSISTENCY_MANAGER     I SET_ENABLE                    Enable / Disable consistency checks                         .
IF_WDK_EXT_NAVIGATION_CONSUMER I GET_LAYOUT_INFO               Get layout information                                      .
IF_WDK_EXT_NAVIGATION_CONSUMER I GET_TARGETS                   Get external targets                                        .
IF_WDK_EXT_NAVIGATION_CONSUMER I GET_TARGET_PARAMETER          Navigate to target                                          .
IF_WDK_FP_CONTROLLER           I GET_CONSISTENCY_MANAGER       Get data consistency manager                                .
IF_WDK_FP_CONTROLLER           I GET_UNDO_MANAGER              Get Undo buffer                                             .
IF_WDK_FP_CONTROLLER           I NAVIGATE_TO_SPOOL_PDF         do Object based naviagtion to spool converter               .
IF_WDK_FP_CONTROLLER           I SYNCHRONIZE                   Internal DO NOT USE                                         .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZABLE            I DESERIALIZE                   Deserialize                                                 .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZABLE            I SERIALIZE                     Serialize                                                   .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZATION           I CAN_DESERIALIZE               Can Deserialize from XML string                             .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZATION           I CAN_SERIALIZE                 Can Serialize into XML string                               .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZATION           I DESERIALIZE                   Deserialize from XML string                                 .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZATION           I SERIALIZE                     Serialize into XML string                                   .
IF_WDK_SERIALIZATION           I SET_COMMENT                   Set comment                                                 .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I CAN_REDO                      Redo possible                                               .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I CAN_UNDO                      Undo possible                                               .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I CLEAR_REDO_STACK              Clear undo stack                                            .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I DEREGISTER_NODE               Deregister node for undo / redo                             .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I GET_STACKS                    Get undo / redo stack                                       .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I REDO                          Redo                                                        .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I REDO_ACTION                   Redo (ignores Changelog)                                    .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I REGISTER_NODE                 Register node for undo / redo                               .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I UNDO                          Undo                                                        .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I UNDO_ACTION                   Undo (ignores Changelog)                                    .
IF_WDK_UNDO_MANAGER            I UNDO_TO_STATE                 Undo to state                                               .
IF_WDP_CONFIG_GENERIC_FORM     I GET_FORM_CONFIG               Returns Form Configuration                                  .
IF_WDP_CONFIG_SIMPLE_FORM      I GET_FORM_CONFIGURATION        Returns Form Configuration                                  .
IF_WDP_CONFIG_SIMPLE_TABLE     I GET_TABLE_CONFIG              Returns Table Configuration                                 .
IF_WDR_ADAPTER_EVENT_HANDLER   I HANDLE_AFTER_UPDATE_DATA      Subsequent Data Change after Data Container                 .
IF_WDR_ADAPTER_EVENT_HANDLER   I HANDLE_EVENT                  Universal Event Processing                                  .
IF_WDR_ADAPTER_RENDERER        I DO_POST_RENDERING_SSR         Renders Adapter According to SSR Specification              .
IF_WDR_ADAPTER_RENDERER        I RENDER_SSR                    Renders Adapter According to SSR Specification              .
IF_WDR_CLASSLOADER             I CREATE_INSTANCE               Creates an Instance of Component Class                      .
IF_WDR_CLASSLOADER             I GET_COMPONENT_CONTROLLER      Gets or Creates a Component Controller Instance             .
IF_WDR_CLASSLOADER             I GET_CUSTOM_CONTROLLER         Gets or Creates a Custom Controller Instance                .
IF_WDR_CLASSLOADER             I GET_INTERFACE_VIEW            Gets or Creates an Interface Instance                       .
IF_WDR_CLASSLOADER             I GET_VIEW                      Gets or Creates a View Instance                             .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I ATTACH_FILE_TO_RESPONSE       Adds File to Current Response                               .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I FULFILLS                      Are request instances valid for this client associated      .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I GET_RESOURCE                  Return Data Ressource                                       .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I IS_FIRST_REQUEST              Returns true if the client requests the first request       .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I RESET_CHANGE_FLAG             Resets the Change Flag                                      .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I RESET_PENDING_UPDATES         Resets Accumulated Changes                                  .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I SEND_REDIRECT                 Sends redirect response to client using the specified URL   .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I SEND_RESPONSE                 Render Response & Flush                                     .
IF_WDR_CLIENT                  I SEND_SUSPEND                  Handle suspense of the application                          .
IF_WDR_COMPONENT_DELEGATE      I WD_DO_APPLICATION_STATE_CHANGEState Change of Application                                 .
IF_WDR_COMPONENT_DELEGATE      I WD_DO_BEFORE_NAVIGATION       Navigation                                                  .
IF_WDR_COMPONENT_FACTORY       I CREATE_COMPONENT              Creates and initializes a new Component instance            .
IF_WDR_COMPONENT_FACTORY       I DELETE_COMPONENT              Deletes the given Component instance.                       .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT                 I FIND_NODE_INF_FOR_PATH        Returns the NodeInfo for the node identified by given path  .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT                 I GET_NODE                      Returns the node for the given path of the form '.' node-nam.
IF_WDR_CONTEXT                 I RESET                         Resets the Context.                                         .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT_MANAGER         I GET_CONTEXT                   Returns the context with the given name or null             .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT_MANAGER         I GET_ID                        Returns an ID that hopefully identifies the context manager .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT_MENU_HANDLER    I CONTEXT_MENU_CALLED           Context Menu Called                                         .
IF_WDR_CONTEXT_MENU_HANDLER    I ENTRY_CHOSEN                  Context Menu Entry Selected                                 .
IF_WDR_CONTROLLER_DELEGATE     I WD_DO_EXIT                    Exit the Controller                                         .
IF_WDR_CONTROLLER_DELEGATE     I WD_DO_INIT                    Initialization of the Controller                            .
IF_WDR_CONTROLLER_DELEGATE     I WD_GET_ROOT_NODE_INTERNAL     Gets the Root Node                                          .
IF_WDR_CONTROLLER_DELEGATE     I WD_INVOKE_EVENT_HANDLER       Calls the Event Handler                                     .
IF_WDR_DATA_CONTAINER_MANAGER  I GET_DATACONTAINER             Returns the data container instance corresponding to the giv.
IF_WDR_DIRTY_STATE             I DESTROY                       End Status Monitoring                                       .
IF_WDR_DIRTY_STATE             I IS_DIRTY                      Returns dirty status                                        .
IF_WDR_DIRTY_STATE             I RESET_DIRTY                   Resets dirty flag                                           .
IF_WDR_MESSAGE_AREA            I ADD_MESSAGE                   Adds Message to Message Log                                 .
IF_WDR_MESSAGE_AREA            I ADD_MESSAGES                  Adds Set of Messages to Message Log                         .
IF_WDR_MESSAGE_AREA            I GET_VISIBLE                   Specifies whether the Message Log Is to Be Visible          .
IF_WDR_MESSAGE_AREA            I SET_DISPLAY_PROPERTIES        Set Display Properties of Message Area                      .
IF_WDR_NAVIGATION_LISTENER     I CLEAR_NAVIGATION_Q            clear all navigation requests from the q                    .
IF_WDR_NAVIGATION_LISTENER     I NAVIGATE                      Navigation request to the given view manager                .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I BUILD_VIEW                    Creates View Element Configuration View                     .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I GET_RESET_ENABLED_4_AGGR      Gets the Enabled Value for the Reset Button                 .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I RESET_ON_AGGR_LEVEL           Resets the P13N Data for Aggregation                        .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I RESET_ON_ELEMENT_LEVEL        Resets P13N Data for Entire View Element                    .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I RESET_STRING_VALUE            Resets Value for String Value                               .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I SET_NEW_VIEW_ELEMENT          Sets New View Element                                       .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I SET_OTHER_ATTRIBUTES          Sets Properties for View Element Configuration              .
IF_WDR_P13N_PROP               I SET_VALUES_FOR_AGGREGATIONS   Sets Values for Columns/Tab Titles/etc.                     .
IF_WDR_P13N_SERVICE            I APPLY                         Uses Personalized Values                                    .
IF_WDR_P13N_SERVICE            I GET_PERS_DATA                 Configuration Can Get Personalization Data                  .
IF_WDR_P13N_SERVICE            I RESET                         Resets Personalized Values                                  .
IF_WDR_P13N_SERVICE            I SET_PERS_DATA                 Configuration Passes Personalization Data                   .
IF_WDR_PERSONALIZATION_SERVICE I GET_PERS_VALUE                Gets Current Personalized Value of Property                 .
IF_WDR_PERSONALIZATION_SERVICE I SET_PERS_VALUE                Sets Current Personalized Value of Property                 .
IF_WDR_REC_PLUGIN              I INIT                          Initializes the Plug-In                                     .
IF_WDR_REC_PLUGIN              I ON_SELECTION_RESET            Selection Deleted                                           .
IF_WDR_RR_ABSTRACT_CMP_USAGE   I GET_USED_COMPONENT            Returns Metadata for Used Component                         .
IF_WDR_RR_ABSTRACT_CMP_USAGE   I SET_USED_COMPONENT            Specifies to Which Component this Usage Refers to           .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I ADD_COMPONENT_USAGE           Adds Component Usage to Group                               .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Returns Component Usage to this Group                       .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I GET_COMPONENT_USAGES          Returns All Component Usages to this Group                  .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I REMOVE_ALL_CMP_USAGES         Deletes All Component Usages from this Group                .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I REMOVE_COMPONENT_USAGE        Deletes a Component Usage from this Group                   .
IF_WDR_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP      I SET_CARDINALITY               Sets Cardinality                                            .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I CLONE_COMPONENT_USAGE         Creates metadata for a component view based on template     .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I CREATE_CMP_USAGE_GROUP        Creates a Group of Component Usages                         .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I CREATE_COMPONENT_USAGE        Creates Temporary Metadata for Component Usage              .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I CREATE_WINDOW                 Creates temporary metadata for window                       .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_CMP_USAGE_GROUP           Returns Metadata of Component Usage Group                   .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_CMP_USAGE_GROUPS          Returns Metadata of All Component Usage Groups              .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Returns Metadata of Component Usage                         .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_COMPONENT_USAGES          Returns Metadata of All Component Usages                    .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_CONTROLLER                Returns Metadata of Controller                              .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_CONTROLLERS               Returns Metadata of All Controllers                         .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_CTLR_TEXT                 Returns All OTR Texts for Controller                        .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_OTR_TEXT                  Returns All OTR Texts for Component                         .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_USED_COMPONENT            Returns Metadata of Component                               .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_VIEW                      Returns Metadata of View                                    .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_VIEWS                     Returns Metadata of All Views                               .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_VIEW_TEXT                 Returns All OTR Texts for View                              .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_WINDOW                    Returns Metadata of Window                                  .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I GET_WINDOWS                   Returns Metadata of All Windows                             .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I REMOVE_USED_COMPONENT         Deletes Metadata References of Used Component               .
IF_WDR_RR_COMPONENT            I REMOVE_WINDOW                 Deletes Temporary Metadata for Window                       .
IF_WDR_RR_CONTROLLER           I GET_ACTION                    Returns Metadata of Action                                  .
IF_WDR_RR_CONTROLLER           I GET_EVENT                     Returns Metadata of Event                                   .
IF_WDR_RR_CONTROLLER           I GET_EVENT_HANDLER             Returns Metadata of Event Handler                           .
IF_WDR_RR_CONTROLLER           I GET_EVENT_HANDLER_FOR_ACTION  Returns Metadata of Event Handler for Action                .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I CREATE_OUTBOUND_PLUG          Creates Temporary Metadata for Outbound Plug                .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I CREATE_VIEW_CONTAINER         Creates Temporary Metadata for View Container               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I DELETE_OUTBOUND_PLUG          Deletes Temporary Metadata from Outbound Plug               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I DELETE_VIEW_CONTAINER         Deletes Temporary Metadata from View Container              .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_ACTION_FOR_EVT_BINDING    Returns Metadata of Action                                  .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_EVENT_BINDING             Returns Metadata for Event Binding                          .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_EVENT_HANDLER_FOR_INPLUG  Returns Event Handler for Inbound Plug                      .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_IMPLEMENTATION_WINDOW     Returns Window for Interface View                           .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_INBOUND_PLUG              Returns Metadata of Inbound Plug                            .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_NAV_LINKS_FOR_OUTPLUG     All Navigation Links for Outbound Plug                      .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_NAV_TARGETS_FOR_INPLUG    All Navigation Targets for Inbound Plug                     .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_OUTBOUND_PLUG             Returns Metadata of Outbound Plug                           .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_PARAMETERS_FOR_INPLUG     All Parameters for Inbound Plug                             .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_PARAMETER_FOR_INPLUG      Returns Metadata of Parameter for Inbound Plug              .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I GET_VIEW_CONTAINER            Returns Metadata of View Container                          .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I HAS_VIEW_CONTAINER            Does View have Container with Specified Name?               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW                 I SET_LIFESPAN                  Sets Lifetime of View                                       .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I CREATE_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGE    Creates Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I DELETE_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGE    Deletes Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I GET_DEFAULT_VIEW_USAGE        Returns Default View Embedding for View Area                .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I GET_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGES      Returns All View Embeddings for View Area                   .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I GET_EMBEDDED_VUSAGE           Returns View Embedding for View Area                        .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I GET_VIEW_USAGE_FOR_VIEW       Returns View Embedding for Specified View Name              .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I SET_DEFAULT_VIEW_USAGE        Sets Temporary Default View Embedding                       .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT  I SET_VIEW_CONTAINER            Sets Temporary View Container                               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I CREATE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Creates Temporary Navigation Target                         .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I CREATE_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT    Creates Temporary View Container Assignment                 .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I DELETE_ALL_NAVIGATION_TARGETS Temporarily Deletes All Navigation Targets for Outbound Plug.
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I DELETE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Temporarily Deletes Navigation Target                       .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I DELETE_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT    Temporarily Deletes View Container Assignment               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_SOURCE_PLUG_FOR_NAV_LINK  Returns Source of Navigation Link                           .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_TARGETS_FOR_NAV_LINK      All Navigation Targets for Navigation Link                  .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_TARGET_FOR_NAV_LINK       Returns Navigation Target for Navigation Link               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_TARGET_PLUG_FOR_TARGET    Returns Target of Navigation Target                         .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_TARGET_VUSAGE_FOR_TARGET  Returns Target of Navigation Target                         .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_VCA_FOR_CONTAINER         Returns Metadata of View Container Assignment               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_VIEW                      Returns Metadata of Used View                               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENTS      Returns Metadata for All View Container Assignments         .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I GET_VIEW_CONTAINER_ASSIGNMENT Returns Metadata of View Container Assignment               .
IF_WDR_RR_VIEW_USAGE           I SET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Sets Temporary Component Usage                              .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I CREATE_NAVIGATION_LINK        Creates Temporary Navigation Link                           .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I CREATE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Creates Dynamically Created Navigation Target               .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I CREATE_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE        Creates Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I DELETE_ALL_NAVIGATION_TARGETS Deletes All Dynamically Created Navigation Targets          .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I DELETE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Deletes One Dynamically Created Navigation Target           .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I DELETE_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE        Temporarily Deletes Metadata of View Embedding              .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_NAVIGATION_LINK           Returns Metadata for Navigation Link                        .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_RESUME_PLUG               Returns Resume Plug if Exists                               .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE           Returns Metadata for View Embedding                         .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_ROOT_VIEW_USAGES          Returns Metadata for All Top-Level View Embeddings          .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_SOURCE_VUSAGE_FOR_NAV_LINKReturns Metadata for View Embedding                         .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_TARGETS_FOR_NAV_LINK      All Navigation Targets for Navigation Link                  .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_TARGET_FOR_NAV_LINK       Returns Navigation Target for Navigation Link               .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_TARGET_PLUG_FOR_TARGET    Returns Target of Navigation Target                         .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_TARGET_VUSAGE_FOR_TARGET  Returns Target of Navigation Target                         .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_VIEW_USAGE                Returns Metadata for View Embedding                         .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I GET_VIEW_USAGES               Returns Metadata for All View Embeddings                    .
IF_WDR_RR_WINDOW               I SET_DEFAULT_ROOT_VUSAGE       Sets Temporary Default View                                 .
IF_WDR_SCX_ADAPTER_EVT_HANDLER I GET_PARAMETER_MAP             Get Event Parameter Map                                     .
IF_WDR_SHLP_CONTEXT_MANAGER    I GET_VALUES                    Maps SHLP Interface to Application Fields                   .
IF_WDR_SHLP_CONTEXT_MANAGER    I SET_VALUES                    Sets Fields of Application with Search Result               .
IF_WDR_SHLP_DISPLAY_MANAGER    I DISPLAY_COLLECTIVE_SEARCH_HELPDisplay of Collective Search Help                           .
IF_WDR_SHLP_DISPLAY_MANAGER    I DISPLAY_ELEMENTARY_SEARCH_HELPDisplay of Elementary Search Help                           .
IF_WDR_STATS                   I READ_STATS                    Read Statistics from Shared Memory                          .
IF_WDR_STATS                   I UPDATE_STATS                  Update Statistics in Shared Memory                          .
IF_WDR_TRACE_TOOL              I DO_REDIRECT                   Execute Redirect to Trace Tool                              .
IF_WDR_TRACE_TOOL              I END_ROUNDTRIP                 Close Roundtrip                                             .
IF_WDR_TRACE_TOOL              I IS_REDIRECT                   Redirect to trace tool requested?                           .
IF_WDR_TRACE_TOOL              I START_ROUNDTRIP               Start Roundtrip                                             .
IF_WDR_UCF_RESOURCE_HANDLER    I GET_ON_DEMAND_RESOURCE        Returns Binary Data of Resource                             .
IF_WDR_UCF_RUNTIME_CALLBACK    I FILL_WDR_TASK                 Fill WDR_TASK                                               .
IF_WDR_UCF_RUNTIME_CALLBACK    I IS_UCF_RENDERING_USED         Check Whether UCF Is to Perform Rendering                   .
IF_WDR_UCF_RUNTIME_CALLBACK    I PRELOAD_APPLICATION           Loads Application                                           .
IF_WDR_UR_CUSTOM_MENU          I SET_CONTENT                   Process Adapter                                             .
IF_WDR_USER_INPUT_LISTENER     I ON_CHANGE                     Changes Made                                                .
IF_WDR_VALUE_HELP_LISTENER     I ON_AFTER_COMPONENT_CREATION   Is Called After Generation of Value Help Component          .
IF_WDR_VD_ADAPTER              I FINALIZE                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_WDR_VD_ADAPTER              I HANDLE_EVENT                  Process Adapter Event                                       .
IF_WDR_VD_ADAPTER              I SET_CONTENT                   Process Adapter                                             .
IF_WDR_VIEW_DELEGATE           I WD_DO_AFTER_ACTION            Query after performing an action                            .
IF_WDR_VIEW_DELEGATE           I WD_DO_BEFORE_ACTION           Validation of User Input                                    .
IF_WDR_VIEW_DELEGATE           I WD_DO_MODIFY_VIEW             Modification of View                                        .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I FINALIZE                      Destructor                                                  .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I GET_FOCUS_HTML_ID             Determine Focus HTML ID                                     .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I GET_RESOURCE                  Get Resource                                                .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I HANDLE_AFTER_UPDATE_DATA      Get Resource                                                .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I HANDLE_EVENT                  Get Resource                                                .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_ADAPTER    I SET_CONTENT                   Process Adapter                                             .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_FACTORY    I CREATE_ELEMENT                Creates a View Element                                      .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_FACTORY    I CREATE_LAYOUT                 Creates the Layout of a View                                .
IF_WDR_VIEW_ELEMENT_FACTORY    I CREATE_LAYOUT_DATA            Creates Layout Data                                         .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I CLEAR                         Delete Content                                              .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I CLOSE                         Write Process Completed, Flush Content                      .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I FLUSH_TO_WRITER               Write Content in Specified Writer                           .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I GET_CONTENT                   Writer Content                                              .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I NEW_LINE                      Print('\r\n')                                               .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I OUT                           Write a Text Segment (Without Escaping!)                    .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I PRINT                         Write a Text (Any Type) in the Output Stream                .
IF_WDR_WRITER                  I PRINT_STRING                  Writing Text Section                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_CUSTOM_EVENT         I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_ERROR_HANDLER        I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I GET_ERROR_HANDLER             GET_ERROR_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I GET_EVENT_SOURCE              GET_EVENT_SOURCE                                            .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I GET_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT          GET_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I HAS_ERROR_HANDLER             HAS_ERROR_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I HAS_EVENT_SOURCE              HAS_EVENT_SOURCE                                            .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I HAS_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT          HAS_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I SET_ERROR_HANDLER             SET_ERROR_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I SET_EVENT_SOURCE              SET_EVENT_SOURCE                                            .
IF_WDY_MD_EVENT_HANDLER        I SET_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT          SET_SUBSCRIBED_EVENT                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_INCOMING_EVENT       I GET_EVENT_HANDLER             GET_EVENT_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_INCOMING_EVENT       I HAS_EVENT_HANDLER             HAS_EVENT_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_INCOMING_EVENT       I SET_EVENT_HANDLER             SET_EVENT_HANDLER                                           .
IF_WDY_MD_LOCKABLE_OBJECT      I COPY                          Copy                                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_METHOD               I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I GET_ABAP_TYPE                 GET_ABAP_TYPE                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I GET_ABAP_TYPING               GET_ABAP_TYPING                                             .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I GET_DECLARATION_TYPE          GET_DECLARATION_TYPE                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I GET_OWNER                     GET_OWNER                                                   .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I HAS_TYPE                      HAS_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I SET_ABAP_TYPE                 SET_ABAP_TYPE                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I SET_ABAP_TYPING               SET_ABAP_TYPING                                             .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I SET_DECLARATION_TYPE          SET_DECLARATION_TYPE                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAMETER            I SET_TYPE                      SET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I CREATE_PARAMETER              CREATE_PARAMETER                                            .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I GET_PARAMETERS                GET_PARAMETERS                                              .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I GET_PARAMETER_BY_NAME         GET_PARAMETER_BY_NAME                                       .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I GET_PARAMETER_BY_POS          GET_PARAMETER_BY_POS                                        .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I GET_PARAMETER_COUNT           GET_PARAMETER_COUNT                                         .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I GET_PARAMETER_POSITION        GET_PARAMETER_POSITION                                      .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I HAS_PARAMETER                 HAS_PARAMETER                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_PARAM_FEATURE        I MOVE_PARAMETER                MOVE_PARAMETER                                              .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I GET_READONLY                  GET_READONLY                                                .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I GET_TYPE                      GET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I GET_VISIBILITY                GET_VISIBILITY                                              .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I HAS_TYPE                      HAS_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I SET_READONLY                  SET_READONLY                                                .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I SET_TYPE                      SET_TYPE                                                    .
IF_WDY_MD_PROPERTY             I SET_VISIBILITY                SET_VISIBILITY                                              .
IF_WDY_MD_VALIDATOR            I GET_APP_CLASS                 GET_APP_CLASS                                               .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I APPLY_TEMPLATE                Use of Template                                             .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_DESCRIPTION      Returns Description of Template                             .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_GROUP            Grouping for Templates                                      .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_ICON             Returns Icon for Template Gallery                           .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_NAME             Returns Name of Template                                    .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_OBJECT           Returns Object of Template Class                            .
IF_WDY_WB_DESIGNTIME_TEMPLATE  I GET_TEMPLATE_TARGET           Target of Template (View,Controller,Window,Component)       .
IF_WD_ACTION                   I SET                           Sets the Attributes of Action                               .
IF_WD_APPLICATION              I GET_APPLICATION_INFO          Returns the Metadata Description of Application             .
IF_WD_APPLICATION              I GET_CLIENT_ENVIRONMENT        Returns which client environment Web Dynpro is running in   .
IF_WD_APPLICATION              I GET_REMOTE_ADDRESS            Returns the caller's IP address                             .
IF_WD_BADI_DOMODIFYVIEW        I WDDOMODIFYVIEW                Modifies the layout of a view                               .
IF_WD_BUSIN_GRAPHICS_MTD_HNDL  I ADD_DIRECT_CUSTOMIZING        Set Additional Customizing                                  .
IF_WD_BUSIN_GRAPHICS_MTD_HNDL  I CLEAR_DIRECT_CUSTOMIZING      Delete Additional Customizing                               .
IF_WD_BUSIN_GRAPHICS_MTD_HNDL  I GET_DIRECT_CUSTOMIZING        Get Additional Customizing                                  .
IF_WD_BUSIN_GRAPHICS_MTD_HNDL  I GET_DIRECT_CUSTOMIZING_MODE   Get Mode for Additional Customizing                         .
IF_WD_BUSIN_GRAPHICS_MTD_HNDL  I SET_DIRECT_CUSTOMIZING_MODE   Set Mode for Additional Customizing                         .
IF_WD_CHANNEL_EVENT_TRIGGER    I CHECK_FOR_EVENT_CONDITION     Trigger Event on Channel?                                   .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I BINARY_TO_STRING              raw -" string                                               .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I BOOLEAN_TO_STRING             boolean -" string                                           .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I DATE_TO_STRING                date -" string                                              .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I DECIMAL_TO_STRING             decimal -" string                                           .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I FLOAT_TO_STRING               floating point types -"string                               .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I INTEGER_TO_STRING             integeger types -" string                                   .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I NUM_TO_STRING                 Num -" string                                               .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_BINARY              string -" raw                                               .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_BOOLEAN             string  -" boolean                                          .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_DATE                string -" date                                              .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_DECIMAL             string -" decimal                                           .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_FLOAT               string -" floating point types                              .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_INTEGER             string -" integer types                                     .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_NUM                 string -" num                                               .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_TIME                string -" time                                              .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I STRING_TO_VISIBILITY          string -" visibility                                        .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I TIME_TO_STRING                time -" string                                              .
IF_WD_CLIENT_CONVERSION_UTIL   I VISIBILITY_TO_STRING          Visibility -" string                                        .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I ADD_EVENT_HANDLER             Registers an Event Handler for an Event                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I CANCEL_NAVIGATION             Prevents Navigation in Entire Application                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I CREATE_CMP_USAGE_GROUP        Creates a Component Usage Group                             .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I DELETE_CONFIGURATION          Obsolete: Use Method from IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION             .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_APPLICATION               Returns Reference to Application Object                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_CMP_USAGE_GROUP           Returns a Reference to Component Usage Group                .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_COMPONENT_INFO            Returns Metadata Description of Component                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_CONFIGURATION_KEY         Returns Current Configuration Key or Initial                .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_ID                        Returns Unique ID of Component                              .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_PERSONALIZATION_MANAGER   Returns Reference to Personalization Manager                .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_PORTAL_MANAGER            Returns Reference to Portal Manager                         .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_SAPGUI_MANAGER            Returns a reference to the SAPGUI Manager                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I GET_WINDOW_MANAGER            Returns a reference to the Window Manager                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I HAS_CMP_USAGE_GROUP           Does Component Usage Group Exist?                           .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I LOAD_CONFIGURATION_BY_KEY     Obsolete: Use Method from IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION             .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER          Deregisters Event Handler from Event                        .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I REMOVE_PENDING_INPUT          Deletes User Input that Was Not Transferred                 .
IF_WD_COMPONENT                I SAVE_CONFIGURATION            Obsolete: Use Method from IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION             .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_ASSISTANCE     I GET_TEXT                      Returns Text of Model Class                                 .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I ADD_EVENT_HANDLER             Registers an Event Handler for an Event                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I CREATE_COMPONENT              Creates Component                                           .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I CREATE_COMP_USAGE_OF_SAME_TYPECreates Component Usage of Same Type                        .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I DELETE_COMPONENT              Deletes Component                                           .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I ENTER_REFERENCING_MODE        Transfers this Component Usage in Referencing Mode          .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE_INFO      Metadata Description of Component Usage                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I GET_INTERFACE_CONTROLLER      Returns Reference to Interface Controller                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I HAS_ACTIVE_COMPONENT          Specifies Whether Active Component Exists                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I IS_REFERENCED                 Component Usage Is to Be Referenced?                        .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I IS_REFERENCING                Is Component Usage in Referencing Mode?                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I LEAVE_REFERENCING_MODE        Exists Referencing Mode                                     .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE          I REMOVE_EVENT_HANDLER          Deregisters Event Handler from Event                        .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I ADD_COMPONENT_USAGE           Creates and Adds a Component Usage                          .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Return a Component Usage to this Group                      .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I GET_COMPONENT_USAGES          Return All Component Usages to this Group                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I REMOVE_ALL_CMP_USAGES         Deletes All Component Usages from this Group                .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I REMOVE_COMPONENT_USAGE        Deletes a Component Usage from this Group                   .
IF_WD_COMPONENT_USAGE_GROUP    I SET                           Sets Properties of a Component Usage                        .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I ADD_ELEMENT                   Creates New Element (at End)                                .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I ADD_ELEMENTS                  Creates New Elements (at End)                               .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I INVALIDATE_NODE               Invalidates a Node                                          .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I MOVE_ELEMENT                  Moves an Element                                            .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I REMOVE_ELEMENT                Deletes an Element                                          .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets an Attribute                                           .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_ATTRIBUTE_FINAL           Sets an Attribute to Final                                  .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_ELEMENT_FINAL             Sets an Element to Final                                    .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_NODE_FINAL                Sets a Node to Final (Collection)                           .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES         Sets All Attributes                                         .
IF_WD_CONFIG_CONTEXT           I SET_SUBTREE_FINAL             Sets a Node and all Subnodes to Final                       .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I CALC_CONFIG_KEY               Calculates Configuration Key from Usage Path                .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I FILL_CONFIGURATION_CONTEXT    Fills Configuration Context                                 .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I FILL_P13N_ELEMENTS_4_APPL     Collects All Personalized Elements of an Application        .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_CONF_KEY_4_USAGE_PATH     Reads Configuration for Usage Path                          .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_IMPL_4_USAGE_PATH         Gets Implementation Name for Usage Path                     .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_P13N_DATA                 Returns Data for Implicit Personalization                   .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_P13N_ELEMENTS_4_APPL      Gets All Personalized Elements of an Application            .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_PERSONALIZED_COMPONENTS   Returns All Components with Implicit P13N Data              .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I GET_USER_TYPE                 Gets User Type                                              .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I IGNORE_PERSONALIZATION        Personalization Cannot Be Loaded                            .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I INIT                          Initializes Configuration for Application                   .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I LEAVE_CONFIGURATION_CHANGEMODEQuits change mode for the configuration                     .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I LEAVE_PERS_CHANGEMODE         Quits change mode for the personalization                   .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I LOAD_PERSONALIZATION_DATA     Fills Configuration Context                                 .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I REMOVE_CONFIGURATION          Deletes Personalization Data                                .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I REMOVE_PERSONALIZATION_DATA   Deletes Personalization Data                                .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SAVE_CONFIGURATION            Saves Configuration                                         .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SAVE_DEFAULT_VARIANT          Saves Default Variants                                      .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SAVE_PERSONALIZATION_DATA     Saves Personalization Data                                  .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SET_CONFIGURATION_CHANGEMODE  Sets Configuration in Change Mode                           .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SET_IMPL_4_USAGE_PATH         Sets Implementation Name for Usage Path                     .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SET_PERSONALIZATION_CHANGEMODESets Personalization in Change Mode                         .
IF_WD_CONFIG_RUNTIME           I SET_USER_TYPE                 Specifies User Type                                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT                  I ADD_CONTEXT_ATTRIBUTE_CHANGE  Adds an Entry for Attribute Changes                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT                  I RESET_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT       Resets the changed by client flag in the context, i. e. in a.
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns the Value of an Attribute                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPERTIES      Reads the properties of an attribute                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_ELEM  Reads the properties of attributes of this element          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_ATTRIBUTE_REF             Returns Reference to Copy of Attribute Value                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_CHILD_NODE                Returns Child Node of this Element                          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_CHILD_NODES               Returns All Lower-Level Nodes of this Element               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_INDEX                     Returns Index of Element                                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_NODE                      Returns Node to Which Element Belongs                       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_PATH                      Returns Path to Element                                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES         Returns Copy of All Statically Declared Attributes          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_REF     Returns Reference to a Copy of All Static Attributes        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I IS_ATTRIBUTE_FINALIZED        True if Attribute of Element Can No Longer Be Changed       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I IS_ATTRIBUTE_NULL             Returns True if Attribute Is NULL                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I IS_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT          True if Element Is Changed by Client                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I IS_FINALIZED                  True if Element Can No Longer Be Changed                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I IS_SELECTED                   True, if element is selected in the node                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets the Attribute Value                                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_ATTRIBUTE_FINALIZED       Denotes Attribute as No Longer Modifiable(Except Invalidate).
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NULL            Sets Attribute to NULL                                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPERTY        Sets an attribute property                                  .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_ELEM  Sets the attribute properties for this element              .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT         Denotes Element as Changed by Client                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_FINALIZED                 Denotes Element as No Longer Modifiable (Except Invalidate) .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_SELECTED                  Sets Element as Selected to Node                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES         Sets the Value of Statically Declared Attributes            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I SET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_NULL    Sets all Static Attributes to NULL                          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_ELEMENT          I TO_XML                        Returns Canonical XML                                       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I BIND_ELEMENT                  Binds Element  (SET_INITIAL_ELEMENTS=ABAP_TRUE)             .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I BIND_ELEMENTS                 Binds Elemente  (SET_INITIAL_ELEMENTS=ABAP_TRUE)            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I BIND_STRUCTURE                Binds Structure  (SET_INITIAL_ELEMENTS=ABAP_TRUE)           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I BIND_TABLE                    Binds Table  (SET_INITIAL_ELEMENTS=ABAP_TRUE)               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I CLEAR_SELECTION               Deletes Selection                                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I CREATE_ELEMENT                Creates an Element with all Static Attributes               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I CREATE_ELEMENT_STATIC_ATTR    Exclusively Creates the Statically Declared Attributes      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns the Value of an Attribute                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPERTIES      Reads the properties of an attribute                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_ELEM  Reads attribute properties for an element                   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_NODE  Reads attribute properties of this node                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ATTRIBUTE_REF             Returns Reference to Copy of Attribute Value                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_CHILD_NODE                Child Node of Lead Selection or Specific Index              .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_CHILD_NODES               All Lower-Level Nodes of Lead Selection or Specific Index   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_CONTEXT                   Provides Context                                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ELEMENT                   Element of Lead Selection or Specific Index                 .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ELEMENTS                  Returns All Elements                                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_ELEMENT_COUNT             Returns Number of Node Elements                             .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_LEAD_SELECTION            Returns Element of Lead Selection                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_LEAD_SELECTION_INDEX      Returns Index of Lead Seletion                              .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_META_PATH                 Returns the Meta Path of the Node Including the Controller  .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_NODE_INFO                 Returns Meta Information About Node                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_PARENT_ELEMENT            Returns the Element whose Child Node this Node Is           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_PATH                      Returns the Path Including Controller and Element Indices   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_SELECTED_ELEMENTS         Returns All Selected Elements                               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES         Returns Copy of All Statically Declared Attributes          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_REF     Returns Reference to a Copy of All Static Attributes        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_TABLE   Returns All Static Attributes of All Elements               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I INVALIDATE                    Invalidates All Elements of Node                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I IS_ATTRIBUTE_NULL             Returns TRUE if Attribute Is NULL                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I IS_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT          True if Node or Element Is Changed by Client                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I IS_FINALIZED                  True if Node Can No Longer Be Changed                       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I IS_SELECTED                   True if Element Is Selected                                 .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I IS_SUPPLIED                   True if Supply Method Has Already Run                       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_ELEMENT                  Moves Element from Index FROM to Index TO                   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_FIRST                    Set Lead Selection to First Node Element                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_LAST                     Set Lead Selection to Last Node Element                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_NEXT                     Set Lead Selection to Subsequent Node Element               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_PREVIOUS                 Set Lead Selection to Previous Node Element                 .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I MOVE_TO                       Set Lead Selection to Specified Node Element                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I PATH_GET_ATTRIBUTE            Resolves the Path to an Attribute                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I PATH_GET_ELEMENT              Resolves the Path to an Elenemt                             .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I PATH_GET_NODE                 Resolves the Path to Node                                   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I REMOVE_ELEMENT                Removes Single Element if Existing                          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I RESET_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT       Resets CHANGED_BY_CLIENT Flag (Recursive).                  .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_ATTRIBUTE                 Sets the Value of Individual Attribute                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_ATTRIBUTE_NULL            Sets Value of Individual Attributes to NULL                 .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPERTY        Sets attribute properties for an attribute                  .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_ELEM  Sets attribute properties for an element                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_ATTRIBUTE_PROPS_FOR_NODE  Sets attribute properties for this node                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_CHANGED_BY_CLIENT         Denotes Node as Changed by Client                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_FINALIZED                 Denotes Node as No Longer Modifiable (Except Invalitdate)   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_LEAD_SELECTION            Set Element of Lead Selection with Index                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_LEAD_SELECTION_INDEX      Set Element of Lead Selection with Index                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_SELECTED                  Set Element as Selected or Remove Flag                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES         Sets the Value of Statically Declared Attributes            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I SET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_NULL    Sets the Value of Statically Declared Attributes to NULL    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE             I TO_XML                        Returns Canonical XML Representation                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I ADD_ATTRIBUTE                 Adds an Attribute                                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I ADD_CHILD_NODE                Adds a Lower-Level Node                                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I ADD_NEW_CHILD_NODE            Creates a Info Object and Adds it as a Lower-Level Node     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I ADD_NEW_MAPPED_CHILD_NODE     Defines Newly Mapped Lower-Level Node                       .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I ADD_RECURSIVE_CHILD_NODE      Adds a Lower-Level Node                                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I FOLLOW_PATH                   Follows the Path and Returns the Target Node                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns an Attribute                                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_ATTRIBUTES                Delivers All Attributes                                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PROPS    Gets the formatting properties for an attribute             .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUEHELP_TYPE  Returns Type of Input Help of Attribute                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_HELP      Returns value help for an attribute                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_CHILD_NODE                Returns a Lower-Level Node                                  .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_CHILD_NODES               Returns All Lower-Level Nodes                               .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_CONTROLLER                Returns Corresponding Controller                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_NAME                      Returns Node Name                                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_PARENT                    Returns Parent Node                                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_PRIMARY_ATTRIBUTE         Returns Primary Attribute or Is Initial                     .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I GET_STATIC_ATTRIBUTES_TYPE    Returns RTTI Object for Structure Type of Static Attributes .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I HAS_ATTRIBUTE                 Returns Flag: Attribute Has Input Help                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I HAS_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_HELP      Returns Flag: Attribute Has Input Help                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_CHILD_NODE_RECURSIVE       Returns ABAP_TRUE if Specified Child Node Is Rekursive      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_FINALIZED                  True if Node Info Cannot Be Changed                         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_INITIALIZE_LEAD_SELECTION  ABAP_TRUE, Lead Selection Is Automatically Initialized      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_MANDATORY                  ABAP_TRUE, Collection Must Have at least One Element        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_MANDATORY_SELECTION        ABAP_TRUE, Selection Must Have at least One Element         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_MAPPING_COMPLETE           ABAP_TRUE if Mapping Is Complete                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_MULTIPLE                   ABAP_TRUE, Collection Can Have More than One Element        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_MULTIPLE_SELECTION         ABAP_TRUE, Selection Can Have More than One Element         .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I IS_SINGLETON                  ABAP_TRUE, Node Is Singleton                                .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I REMOVE_ATTRIBUTE              Deletes an Attribute                                        .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I REMOVE_CHILD_NODE             Deletes Lower-Level Node                                    .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I REMOVE_DYNAMIC_ATTRIBUTES     Deletes All Attributes of Node                              .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PROPS    Sets the formatting properties for an attribute             .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_ATTRIBUTE_REFERENCE_FIELD Sets the reference field for an attribute                   .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_ATTRIBUTE_REF_CALLBACK    Defines a callback to get the attribute reference           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_HELP      Sets value help for an attribute                            .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALUE_SET       Sets the fixed values for an attribute                      .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_FINALIZED                 Marks Node Info as Not Modifiable                           .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_MAPPING_COMPLETE          Completes an External Mapping Once                          .
IF_WD_CONTEXT_NODE_INFO        I SET_NULLABLE                  Specifies Whether an Attribute Can Have the Value NULL      .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_ACTION                    Returns Reference to Action                                 .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_COMPONENT                 Returns Reference to Component                              .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_CONTEXT                   Returns Reference to Context                                .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_CONTROLLER_INFO           Reference to Metadata Object of Controller                  .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_MESSAGE                   Returns Message Text                                        .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_MESSAGE_MANAGER           Returns Reference to Message Manager                        .
IF_WD_CONTROLLER               I GET_PERSONALIZATION_MANAGER   Returns Reference to Personalization Manager                .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I FROM_STRING                   Converts String to Value                                    .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I IS_BOOLEAN_BY_DATA            Checks Whether a Variable Is "Boolean"                      .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I IS_BOOLEAN_BY_NAME            Checks Whether a Type Is "Boolean"                          .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I IS_BOOLEAN_BY_TYPEDESCR       Internal "Boolean" Test                                     .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I TO_INTEGER                    Converts String to Integer                                  .
IF_WD_CONVERSION_UTILS         I TO_STRING                     Converts Value to String                                    .
IF_WD_DATA_CONTAINER           I SET_VALUE                     Sets the Value (Must Have Correct Type)                     .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_A_TAG                  Render "a" Tag                                              .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_CLOSE_TAG              Render XHTML Tag (PARSE_XHTML_TAGS=ABAP_TRUE)               .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_IMG_TAG                Render "img" Tag                                            .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_OPEN_TAG               Render XHTML Tag (PARSE_XHTML_TAGS=ABAP_TRUE)               .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_PARSED_XML             Render Parsed XML (PARSE_XHTML_TAGS=ABAP_FALSE)             .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_SAP_ACTION_TAG         Render "sap:action" Tag                                     .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_SAP_FIELD_TAG          Render "sap:field" Tag                                      .
IF_WD_FORMATTED_TEXT_RENDERER  I RENDER_TEXT                   Render Text (PARSE_XHTML_TAGS=ABAP_TRUE)                    .
IF_WD_HELLO_APPLICATION        I WD_CREATE_CONTEXT_ELEMENT     Generates Context Element                                   .
IF_WD_HELLO_APPLICATION        I WD_CURRENT_CONTEXT_ELEMENT    Gets Element Interface of Lead Selection                    .
IF_WD_HELLO_APPLICATION        I WD_GET_API                    Gets Application Interface                                  .
IF_WD_HELLO_APPLICATION        I WD_NODE_CONTEXT               Gets Node Interface of Lead Selection                       .
IF_WD_IACTIVE_FORM_METHOD_HNDL I GET_HIDE_TOOLBARS             Returns the value for the "HideToolbars" attribute          .
IF_WD_IACTIVE_FORM_METHOD_HNDL I GET_LEGACY_EDITING_ENABLED    Returns the Option Editable from PDF Created by FM Interface.
IF_WD_IACTIVE_FORM_METHOD_HNDL I SET_HIDE_TOOLBARS             Sets the "HideToolbars" attribute                           .
IF_WD_IACTIVE_FORM_METHOD_HNDL I SET_LEGACY_EDITING_ENABLED    Sets the Option Editable from PDF Created by FM Interface   .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_ACTIVE_VSW_KEY            Sets Active View Switch                                     .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_RLD_CONTENT               Fill 'Related Documents' with Actions                       .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_RLD_HEADER                Sets Heading for RLD Tray                                   .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_RLD_PROPERTIES            Set Tray Attributes for RLD                                 .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_VSW_CONTENT               Fill View Switch with Actions                               .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_VSW_PROPERTIES            Set Group Attributes for VSW                                .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_YCA_CONTENT               Fill 'You Can Also' with Actions                            .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_YCA_HEADER                Set Heading for YCA Tray                                    .
IF_WD_LAYOUT_CNP_LIGHT         I SET_YCA_PROPERTIES            Set Tray Attributes for YCA                                 .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I CLEAR_MESSAGES                Delete All Messages                                         .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I IS_EMPTY                      Query Whether Messages Exist                                .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_ATTRIBUTE_EXCEPTION     Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_ERROR_MESSAGE           Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_EXCEPTION               Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_FATAL_ERROR_MESSAGE     Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_FATAL_EXCEPTION         Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I RAISE_T100_ERROR              Obsolete                                                    .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_ATTRIBUTE_ERROR_MESSAGEReports a WD Exception for a Context Attribute              .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_ATTRIBUTE_EXCEPTION    Reports a WD Exception for a Context Attribute              .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_ATTRIBUTE_T100_MESSAGE Reports a WD Exception for a Context Attribute              .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_ERROR_MESSAGE          Reports a Web Dynpro Message with Optional Parameters       .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_EXCEPTION              Reports a Web Dynpro Exception (May Return)                 .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_FATAL_ERROR_MESSAGE    Reports a Fatal WD Exception Message w/ Optional Parameters .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_FATAL_EXCEPTION        Reports a Fatal Web Dynpro Exception                        .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_SUCCESS                Reports a Success Message                                   .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_T100_MESSAGE           Reports a Message Using a T100 Entry                        .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER          I REPORT_WARNING                Reports a Warning                                           .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I ADD_MESSAGE_ITEM_FOR_ATTRIBUTEAdds a message item for an attribute                        .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I ADD_REFERENCING_MESSAGE       Creates Message that References to Other Message            .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I GET_MESSAGE_ITEMS             Gets all messages                                           .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I GET_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_ATTR    Gets the messages for a context attribute                   .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I GET_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_ELEMENT Gets the messages for a context element                     .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I GET_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_NODE    Gets the messages for a context node                        .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I REMOVE_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_ATTR Deletes all messages for an attribute                       .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I REMOVE_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_ELEM Deletes all messages for an element                         .
IF_WD_MESSAGE_MANAGER2         I REMOVE_MESSAGE_ITEMS_FOR_NODE Deletes all messages for a node                             .
IF_WD_NAVIGATION_SERVICES      I DO_DYNAMIC_NAVIGATION         Creates Navigation Link and Performs Navigation             .
IF_WD_NAVIGATION_SERVICES      I PREPARE_DYNAMIC_NAVIGATION    Creates Temporary Navigation Link                           .
IF_WD_NETWORK_METHOD_HNDL      I METHOD1                       Test Method                                                 .
IF_WD_OVS                      I SET_CONFIGURATION             Set Column Headings, Label Texts, and so on                 .
IF_WD_OVS                      I SET_INPUT_STRUCTURE           Set Fields on Selection Screen                              .
IF_WD_OVS                      I SET_OUTPUT_TABLE              Set Hit List                                                .
IF_WD_PACKAGE_SRVS             I INIT_DLG_TADIR                Initializes TADIR Popup                                     .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I DELETE                        Delete Personalization Data                                 .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I ENTER_CHANGE_MODE             Switch to Change Mode                                       .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_CONTEXT_CHANGE_ASSISTANT  Returns an Object for Changes in Configuration Context      .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_DEFAULT_VARIANT           Gets Default for Personalization                            .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_STATE                     Returns Information About Current Load State                .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_VALID_PERS_SCOPE          Returns Maximum Allowed Scope for Storage                   .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_VARIANTS                  Returns List with Variants of Configuration                 .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I GET_VARIANTS_FOR_SUBCOMPONENT Returns List with Variants of Configuration                 .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I IS_IMPLEMENTATION_SUPPLIED    Tests Whether an Implementation Is Specfied for Usage       .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I LEAVE_CHANGE_MODE             Switches to display mode                                    .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I LOAD_CONFIG_BY_KEY            Loads Configuration/Personalization                         .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I RESTRICT_IMPL_PERS            OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I SAVE                          Save Personalization Data                                   .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I SAVE_NEW_VARIANT              Save Personalization Data                                   .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I SET_CONFIG_KEY                Sets Configuration Key for Subsequent Storage of Configur.  .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I SET_DEFAULT_VARIANT           Sets Default for Personalization                            .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I SUPPORT_DELTA_HANDLING        Component Supports Delta Handling of Configuration          .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I TRANSPORT_ALLOWED             Specifies Whether Data Transport Is Allowed                 .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I UNDO_CONTEXT_CHANGES          Resets Configuration Context                                .
IF_WD_PERSONALIZATION          I UPDATE_IMPL_PERS              OBSOLETE                                                    .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM         I SUBSCRIBE_TO_EVENTS           Registration of All Events (See Attributes)                 .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM         I UNSUBSCRIBE_FROM_EVENTS       Deregistration of All Events                                .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM_N       I SUBSCRIBE_TO_BUTTON_EVENT     Registration of a WD Event Handler to a Popup Button        .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM_N       I SUBSCRIBE_TO_CANCEL_BUTTON    Registration of a WD Event Handler to the Cancel Button     .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM_N       I UNSUBSCRIBE_FROM_BUTTON_EVENT Deregistration of a WD Event Handler from a Popup Button    .
IF_WD_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM_N       I UNSUBSCRIBE_FROM_CANCEL_BUTTONDeregistration of a WD Event Handler from the Cancel Button .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I FIRE                          Trigger Portal Event                                        .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I NAVIGATE_ABSOLUTE             Navigation to Defined URL                                   .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I NAVIGATE_RELATIVE             Navigation Relative to Own URL                              .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I NAVIGATE_TO_OBJECT            Navigation to Business Object                               .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I SET_APPLICATION_DIRTY_FLAG    Sets the Dirty Flag for Portal                              .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I SET_WORK_PROTECT_MODE         Sets Mode for Work Protect Mode                             .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I SUBSCRIBE_EVENT               Register Portal Event                                       .
IF_WD_PORTAL_INTEGRATION       I UNSUBSCRIBE_EVENT             Delete Portal Event Registration                            .
IF_WD_PORTAL_SESSION_HANDLING  I IS_RESET_POSSIBLE             Data Base Locks Deleted?                                    .
IF_WD_PORTAL_SESSION_HANDLING  I SESSION_RESTARTS              Session Setting Is Switched from Standby to Running         .
IF_WD_RR_APPLICATION           I GET_HELP_LINK                 Returns the help link                                       .
IF_WD_RR_APPLICATION           I SET_HELP_LINK                 Sets the help link                                          .
IF_WD_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP       I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Returns Component Usage to this Group                       .
IF_WD_RR_CMP_USAGE_GROUP       I GET_COMPONENT_USAGES          Returns All Component Usages to this Group                  .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I CREATE_CMP_USAGE_GROUP        Creates a Group of Component Usages                         .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_CMP_USAGE_GROUP           Returns Metadata of Component Usage Group                   .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Returns Metadata of Component Usage                         .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_CONTROLLER                Returns Metadata of Controller                              .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_IMPL_COMPONENTS           Returns the Names of Implementing Components                .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_NAME                      Name of Component                                           .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_VIEW                      Returns Metadata of View                                    .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT             I GET_WINDOW                    Returns Metadata of Window                                  .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT_USAGE       I GET_LIFECYCLE_CONTROL         Component Creation: Framework/Application                   .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT_USAGE       I GET_NAME                      Name of Component Usage                                     .
IF_WD_RR_COMPONENT_USAGE       I SET_LIFECYCLE_CONTROL         Component Creation: Framework/Application                   .
IF_WD_RR_CONTROLLER            I GET_NAME                      Name of Controller                                          .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW                  I GET_DESCRIPTION               Returns View Description                                    .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW                  I GET_NAME                      Name of View                                                .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW                  I SET_LIFESPAN                  Sets Lifetime of View                                       .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I CREATE_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGE    Creates Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I DELETE_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGE    Deletes Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_ASSIGNED_CONTAINER        Returns Name Corresponding View Container                   .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_DEFAULT_VIEW_USAGE        Returns Default View Embedding                              .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_EMBEDDED_VIEW_USAGES      Returns All View Embeddings for View Area                   .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_EMBEDDED_VUSAGE           Returns View Embedding                                      .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_NAME                      Name of View Container Assignment                           .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_OWNER                     Returns Embedded View Embedding                             .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I GET_VIEW_USAGE_FOR_VIEW       Returns View Embedding                                      .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   I SET_DEFAULT_VIEW_USAGE        Sets Temporary Default View Embedding                       .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I CREATE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Creates Temporary Navigation Target                         .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I CREATE_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT    Creates Temporary View Container Assignment                 .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I DELETE_ALL_NAVIGATION_TARGETS Temporarily Deletes All Navigation Targets for Outbound Plug.
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I DELETE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Temporarily Deletes Navigation Target                       .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I DELETE_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT    Temporarily Deletes View Container Assignment               .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_COMPONENT_USAGE           Returns Component Usage to this View-Embedding              .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_EMB_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT   Returns Embedded View Container Assignment                  .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_NAME                      Name of View Embedding                                      .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_VCA_FOR_CONTAINER         Returns View Container Assignment                           .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_VIEW                      Returns Corresponding View                                  .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENT       Returns Metadata of View Container Assignment               .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_VIEW_CNT_ASSIGNMENTS      Returns Metadata for All View Container Assignments         .
IF_WD_RR_VIEW_USAGE            I GET_WINDOW                    Returns Embedded Window                                     .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I CREATE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Creates Temporary Navigation Target                         .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I CREATE_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE        Creates Temporary Metadata for View Embedding               .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I DELETE_ALL_NAVIGATION_TARGETS Temporarily Deletes All Navigation Targets for Outbound Plug.
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I DELETE_NAVIGATION_TARGET      Temporarily Deletes Navigation Target                       .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I DELETE_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE        Temporarily Deletes Metadata of View Embedding              .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I EMBED_VIEW                    Temporarily Embeds View in Specified Position               .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I GET_NAME                      Returns Window Name                                         .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I GET_ROOT_VIEW_USAGE           Returns Metadata for View Embedding                         .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I GET_ROOT_VIEW_USAGES          Returns Metadata for All Top-Level View Embeddings          .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I GET_VIEW_USAGE                Returns View Embedding                                      .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I GET_VIEW_USAGES               Returns Metadata for All View Embeddings                    .
IF_WD_RR_WINDOW                I SET_DEFAULT_ROOT_VUSAGE       Sets Temporary Default View                                 .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_BLOCK                     Adds Block Group to Selection Screen                        .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_BLOCKS                    Adds Multiple Block Groups to Selection Screen              .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_HORIZONTAL_DIVIDER        Adds Cross Beam to Selection Screen                         .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_HORIZONTAL_DIVIDERS       Adds Multiple Horizontal Bars to Selection Screen           .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_PARAMETER_FIELD           Adds a parameter field to the selection screen              .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_PARAMETER_FIELDS          Adds multiple parameter fields to the selection screen      .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_SELECTION_FIELD           Adds Addtional Field to Selection Screen                    .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_SELECTION_FIELDS          Adds Multiple Fields to Selection Screen                    .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_SELECTION_SCREEN_ITEM     Adds an Element to Selection Screen                         .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_SELECTION_SCREEN_ITEMS    Adds Multiple Elements to Selection Screen                  .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_TEXT_LINE                 Adds Text Line to Selection Screen                          .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I ADD_TEXT_LINES                Adds Multiple Text Lines to Selection Screen                .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I CHECK_ALL_PARAMETER_FIELDS    Checks the correctness of all parameter fields              .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I CHECK_ALL_SELECTION_FIELDS    Checks Entries of All Selection Fields for Correctness      .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I CHECK_SELECTION_SCREEN        Checks the correctness of the entire selection screen       .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I CREATE_RANGE_TABLE            Dynamically Creates Range Table                             .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_BLOCK                     Returns Data of Block Group                                 .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_BLOCKS                    Returns Data of All Block Groups                            .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_HORIZONTAL_DIVIDER        Returns Data of Horizontal Bar                              .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_HORIZONTAL_DIVIDERS       Returns Data of All Horizontal Bars                         .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_PARAMETER_FIELD           Returns the data from a parameter field                     .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_PARAMETER_FIELDS          Returns the data from multiple parameter fields             .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_RANGE_TABLE_OF_SEL_FIELD  Returns Range Table for Selection Field                     .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_SELECTION_FIELD           Returns Data of Selection Field                             .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_SELECTION_FIELDS          Returns Data of All Selection Fields                        .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_SELECTION_SCREEN_ITEM     Returns Data of Element                                     .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_SELECTION_SCREEN_ITEMS    Returns Data of All Elements                                .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_TEXT_LINE                 Returns Data of Text Line                                   .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_TEXT_LINES                Returns Data of All Text Lines                              .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I GET_VALUE_OF_PARAMETER_FIELD  Returns the value of a parameter field                      .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I REMOVE_ALL_SEL_SCREEN_ITEMS   Removes All Elements in Selection Screen                    .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I REMOVE_SELECTION_SCREEN_ITEM  Removes Element in Selection Screen                         .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I RESET_ALL_PARAMETER_FIELDS    Resets the value of all parameter fields                    .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I RESET_ALL_SELECTION_FIELDS    Resets Range Table of All Selection Fields                  .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I RESET_PARAMETER_FIELD         Resets the value of a parameter field                       .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I RESET_SELECTION_FIELD         Resets Range Table of One Selection Field                   .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I SET_GLOBAL_OPTIONS            Sets General Options                                        .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I SET_RANGE_TABLE_OF_SEL_FIELD  Resets Range Table for Selection Field                      .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I SET_VALUE_OF_PARAMETER_FIELD  Sets the value of a parameter field                         .
IF_WD_SELECT_OPTIONS           I UPD_SELECTION_FIELD           Updates the Settings of Selection Field                     .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I APPLY_FILTER                  Filters the Table (Context can be resorted)                 .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I APPLY_SORTING                 Sorts the Table (Context can be resorted)                   .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I EXPAND_INTO_ELEMENT           Expand Tree Table up to Element                             .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I GET_KEY_ATTRIBUTE_NAME        Return Key Attribute for Context Access                     .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I MAKE_ELEMENT_VISIBLE          Make Context Element Visible in Table                       .
IF_WD_TABLE_METHOD_HNDL        I SET_KEY_ATTRIBUTE_NAME        Set Key Attribute for Context Access                        .
IF_WD_TRACE_TOOL               I ADD_TRACE_DATA                Create Trace Dataset                                        .
IF_WD_URL_GENERATOR            I GET_WEB_RESOURCE_PATH         Determines Web Resource Path                                .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_ATTRIBUTE    Gets All Message Strings for Context Attribute              .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_CONTEXT      Gets All Message Strings for Context                        .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_ELEMENT      Gets All Message Strings for Context Element                .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_NODE         Gets All Message Strings for Context Node                   .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I IS_ATTRIBUTE_VALID            Is Attribute Valid?                                         .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I IS_CONTEXT_VALID              Are All Nodes of this Context Valid?                        .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I IS_ELEMENT_VALID              Are All Attributes of this Element Valid?                   .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I IS_NODE_VALID                 Are All Elements of this Node Valid?                        .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I SET_ATTRIBUTE_VALID           Sets an Attribute to Valid                                  .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I SET_CONTEXT_VALID             Sets a Context to Valid                                     .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I SET_ELEMENT_VALID             Sets an Element to Valid                                    .
IF_WD_VALIDATION               I SET_NODE_VALID                Sets a Node to Valid                                        .
IF_WD_VALUE_HELP_LISTENER      I CLOSE_WINDOW                  Input Help Window Is to Be Closed                           .
IF_WD_VIEW                     I GET_ELEMENT                   Gets a View Element Using the ID                            .
IF_WD_VIEW                     I GET_ELEMENTS_BY_CID           Get View Elements Using CID                                 .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I FIRE_PLUG                     Triggers Dynamically Created Outbound Plugs                 .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I GET_CURRENT_ACTION            Returns Action to Be Processed (wddobeforeaction)           .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I GET_EMBEDDING_WINDOW_CTLR     Returns Reference to Embedded Window                        .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I GET_VIEW_INFO                 Reference to the Metadata Object of the View                .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I IS_CURRENT_ACTION_VALIDATING  Returns whether the current action is validating            .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I REQUEST_FOCUS                 Sets the Focus on an Element in the Context                 .
IF_WD_VIEW_CONTROLLER          I REQUEST_FOCUS_ON_ACTION       Sets the Focus on an Action                                 .
IF_WD_VIEW_ELEMENT             I GET_ID                        Returns ID of the View Element                              .
IF_WD_VIEW_ELEMENT             I GET_VIEW                      Returns View for View Element                               .
IF_WD_VIEW_ELEMENT_METHOD_HNDL I CLEAR_METHOD_QUEUE            Deletes Content of Method Queue                             .
IF_WD_VIEW_ELEMENT_METHOD_HNDL I INVOKE_METHOD                 Executes Any Method of View Element                         .
IF_WD_VIEW_ELEMENT_METHOD_HNDL I REMOVE_LOCAL_METHOD_CALLS     Removes All Calls of Assigned View Elements                 .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I CLOSE                         Close Popup (Asynchronous)                                  .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I IS_MODAL                      Is Popup Modal?                                             .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I IS_TOPLEVEL                   Is Popup the Top-Level Popup?                               .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I OPEN                          Open Popup (Asynchronous)                                   .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_BUTTON_KIND               Specifies Button Combination                                .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_CLOSE_BUTTON              Sets the "Close" button                                     .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_MESSAGE_DISPLAY_MODE      Specifies how messages are to be displayed in the popup     .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_MESSAGE_TYPE              Sets Message Type                                           .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_ON_CLOSE_ACTION           Register Action on 'Cancel'                                 .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_REMOVE_ON_CLOSE           Window will be destroyed by closing                         .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_WINDOW_POSITION           Set Window Position                                         .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_WINDOW_POSITION_CONTROL   Set Window Position                                         .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_WINDOW_SIZE               Set Window Size                                             .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SET_WINDOW_TITLE              Set Window Title                                            .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I SUBSCRIBE_TO_BUTTON_EVENT     Register Action on Button Click                             .
IF_WD_WINDOW                   I UNSUBSCRIBE_FROM_BUTTON_EVENT Deregister Action                                           .
IF_WD_WINDOW_CONTROLLER        I GET_MESSAGE_AREA              Returns the message component's API                         .
IF_WD_WINDOW_CONTROLLER        I GET_WINDOW                    Returns Reference to Popup if Exists                        .
IF_WD_WINDOW_CONTROLLER        I GET_WINDOW_INFO               Returns Metadata Description of Window                      .
IF_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER           I CREATE_EXTERNAL_WINDOW        Create New Browser Window                                   .
IF_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER           I CREATE_POPUP_TO_CONFIRM       Creates Dialog Box                                          .
IF_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER           I CREATE_WINDOW                 Create Modal Popup                                          .
IF_WD_WINDOW_MANAGER           I CREATE_WINDOW_FOR_CMP_USAGE   Create Modal Popup                                          .
IF_WEM_CC_FACTORY              I CREATE                        Creates an Object                                           .
IF_WFCC_CHECK                  I EXECUTE_CHECK                 Execution of Check                                          .
IF_WFCC_CHECK                  I EXECUTE_FUNCTION              Executes a selected function                                .
IF_WFCC_CHECK                  I GET_FUNCTIONS                 Gets the possible functions                                 .
IF_WFCC_CHECK                  I GET_PROPERTIES                Read Properties                                             .
IF_WFCC_CHECK                  I GET_TABLE_OF_ENTRIES          Gets the list to be displayed                               .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I AGENTS_GET                    Get Agent                                                   .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I AGENTS_POSSIBLE_GET           Determine Possible Agents of a Step                         .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I AGENTS_SET                    Set pers.responsible                                        .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I AGENT_APPEND                  Add Agent                                                   .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I AGENT_CHECK                   Check agents                                                .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I CHECK_AGENT_ALREADY_STORED    Is the Agent Already Saved?                                 .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I IS_LOCKED                     Checks Whether Step May Still Be Changed                    .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I NOTES_GET                     Get Notes                                                   .
IF_WFD_ADHOC_STEP              I NOTES_SET                     Set Notes                                                   .
IF_WF_DEF_REDO_UNDO            I REDO                          Redo                                                        .
IF_WF_DEF_REDO_UNDO            I UNDO                          Undo                                                        .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_ACCRUAL_LINE           AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line Accruals              .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_AFTER_SUMMARIZATION    AC Interface: Adjust Data After Aggregation                 .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_BEFORE_SUMMARIZATION   AC Interface: Adjust Data Before Aggregation                .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_CANCEL_TYPE            Change Cancellation Method                                  .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE          AC Interface: Change Customer Line                          .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE_ADV_PAYM AC Interface: Change Debtor Advance Pay Posting Line        .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_CUSTOMER_LINE_COND     AC Interface: Change Customer Condition Line                .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_HEADER_LINE            AC Interface: Change Header Data                            .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_ITEM_LINE              AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line                       .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_ITEM_LINE_REMU_LIST    AC Interface: Change G/L Account Line Remuneration List     .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_MATERIAL_LINE          AC Interface: Change Material Line                          .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_POSTING_KEY            Change Posting Key                                          .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_TAX_LINE               AC Interface: Change Tax Line                               .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE            AC Interface: Change Vendor Line                            .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE_ADV_PAYM   AC Interface: Change Creditor Advance Pay Posting Line      .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I CHANGE_VENDOR_LINE_COND       AC Interface: Change Vendor Condition Line                  .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I FICA_DOCUMENT_CHANGE          Change FI-CA Docs of Original Docs of Remuneration Lists    .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I FICA_READ_HEADER_AWKEY        FI-CA Read Document Header for Document                     .
IF_WLF_ACC_ENHANCEMENT         I SET_WRART_CUSTOMERSETTLEMENT  Set Regulation Type for Posting Customer Settlement         .
IF_WLF_CHECK_EXTERNAL_REF      I HEADER_EXISTS_CHECK           Check Header for Existence                                  .
IF_WLF_CHECK_EXTERNAL_REF      I ITEM_EXISTS_CHECK             Check Item for Existence                                    .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_COPY_DEPENDENT          Copy Dependent Entries for Billing Document Type            .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_DELETE_DEPENDENT        Delete Dependent Entries for Billing Document Type          .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_INIT_DEPENDENT          Init                                                        .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_SAVE_DEPENDENT          Save Dependent Entries for Billing Document Type            .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_WRITE_CORR_HDR          Flag Header Entry for Transport                             .
IF_WLF_COPY_LFART_DEPENDENT    I LFART_WRITE_CORR_ITM          Generate Key Entries for Transport                          .
IF_WLF_FLOW_BD                 I CHANGE_FLOW                   Enhance Document Flow Data                                  .
IF_WLF_FORMULA_254             I FORMULA_254                   Application Condition Value Formula 254                     .
IF_WLF_FORMULA_255             I FORMULA_255                   Application Condition Value Formula 255                     .
IF_WLF_FORMULA_256             I FORMULA_256                   Application Condition Value Formula 254                     .
IF_WLF_FORMULA_350             I FORMULA_350                   Application Condition Value Formula 350                     .
IF_WOSZ_AUTH                   I EXTENDED_CHECK                Enhancement of the Authorization Check                      .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I ADD_DATA_FOR_LIST_DISPLAY     Further Displays of Customer-Specific Fields in List Display.
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Global Authorization Check for BAdI                         .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I GET_ALV_FIELDCAT              Provision of Field Catalog for List Display                 .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I GET_MATERIAL_LIST             Reads Material for Vendor                                   .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I GET_SITES                     Reads Plants for Worklist                                   .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I GET_STOCKS_AND_CALC_OOS       Reads Stock Data and Calculates Out-Of-Stock Levels         .
IF_WRBAX_OUT_OF_STOCK          I INIT_OUT_OF_STOCKS            BAdI Initialization                                         .
IF_WRBX_ENTITY                 I CREATE_ENTITY_SEARCH_INSTANCE Delivers an Entity Search Object                            .
IF_WRBX_ENTITY                 I CREATE_MYENTITY_INSTANCE      Delivers a MyEntity Object                                  .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I CALC_VENDOR_OOS_DETAIL        Reads Stock Levels and Calculates Out-of-Stocks for Vendor  .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I CALC_VENDOR_OOS_OVERVIEW      Calculates Out-of-Stock Overview for Vendor                 .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Global Authorization Check                                  .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I GET_MATERIALS                 Reads Materials for a Vendor                                .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I GET_SITES_BY_TYPE             Analyses Plant Category for Plant List Specified            .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I GET_VENDOR_NAME               Delivers the Vendor Name for the Vendor Number              .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I INIT_VENDOR_OUT_OF_STOCKS     Initialization for Out-of-Stocks per Vendor                 .
IF_WRBX_OUT_OF_STOCK           I MERCH_CAT_IS_NOT_VALID        Indicator: Material Group is Invalid                        .
IF_WRB_ENTITY_SEARCH           I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Global Authorization Check for Reading Entity List          .
IF_WRB_ENTITY_SEARCH           I CHECK_AUTHORITY_BY_ENTITY     Authorization Check for Reading Single Entity               .
IF_WRB_ENTITY_SEARCH           I GET_ENTITY_LIST               Read List of Entities for Input Parameter                   .
IF_WRB_MYENTITY                I CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check for Reading Entities                    .
IF_WRB_MYENTITY                I CHECK_AUTHORITY_BY_ENTITY     Authorization Check for Reading Single Entity               .
IF_WRB_MYENTITY                I GET_DESCR_LIST                Read Descriptions for a List of Entity Keys                 .
IF_WRB_MYENTITY                I GET_LIST                      Provides a List of Entities                                 .
IF_WRF_PBAS_UNDO_COMMAND       I IS_VALID                      Undo Command Invalid?                                       .
IF_WRF_PBAS_UNDO_COMMAND       I UNDO                          Undo Command                                                .
IF_WRF_PCTR_REM_QTY            I CUSTOMER_LOGIC                Impl. of Customer-Spec. Logic for Remaining Qty Processing  .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I CHANGE_STATUS                 Status Change                                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I CLEAR_WA                      Empty PPD Work Area                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I CONFLICT_CHECK                Conflict Check                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I CONVERT_MN_TO_PR              Convert Manual Price Plan to Promotion Price Plan           .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I COPY_PPD                      Copy PPD                                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I CREATE_NEW_PPD                Create New Blank PPD in PPD Work Area                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I DEACTIVATE_PPD                Activate/Deactivate Price Plan                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I LOAD_PREVIOUS_PPD             Load Price Plan Loaded Previously                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I PREPARE_CONV_MN_TO_PR         Prepare to Convert Manual to Promotion PPD                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I PREPARE_COPY_PPD              Preparations to Copy a Price Plan                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I REFRESH_BUDGETS               Update Budget Sets                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I REFRESH_PPD                   Update PPD Data                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I REFRESH_WORK_AREA             Update Work Area                                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I SAVE_PPD                      Save PPD in Work Area                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I SEL_TYPE_CHANGED              Sel. Type of Selection Area Was Changed                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_APPLICATION         I TRANSFER_TO_WA                Move Selected Data to PPD Work Area                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_DET_VIEW     I GET_BUDGET_DATA_PBO           Return Budget Data to Ext. Function Group to PBO            .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_DET_VIEW     I INIT_BUDGET_DETAIL_GRID       Initialize Budget Detail - ALV Grid                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_DET_VIEW     I RETURN_FROM_EXT_SCREEN        Return from External Screen (Dialog Box Ext. Funct. Group)  .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I APPLY_NEW_BUDGET_SELECTION    Pass On Range Object to Redetermine Budget                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I CURR_CONV_BUDGET_INFO         Currency Conversion for Budget Info Table                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I FREE                          Reduce Price-Plan-Specific Data                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I FREE_BUDGET_DETAIL            Reduce Relevant Budget Detail Data                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_DETAIL_RELATIONS   Return Specific Budget Values/Relations                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_DETAIL_TABLE_REF   Provide Reference to Budget Detail Data Table               .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_INFO_FOR_DETAIL    Pass on Budget Info Data for Detail Display                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_INFO_IN_OTB_CURR   Currency Conversion for Budget Info Table                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_INFO_IN_PPD_CURR   Currency Conversion for Budget Info Table                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_SET_TABLE_REF      Get Reference to SET Table                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_STATUS             Return Budget Status                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_BUDGET_TYPE               Returns the Current Budget Type                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_FIELDFUNC_LIST            Provide Budget Data Field + Function Classification         .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_HEADER                    Pass On PPD Header Data                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I GET_RELATED_PPD_LIST          Provide PPD List Incl. Planning Levels of Current Budget    .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I LINK_TO_PPD                   Link / Update Budget Set with New PPD                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUDGET_SET          I REFRESH_BUDGET_DATA           Refresh Budget Data                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I FREE                          Dismantle Object -" Delete Self-Reference                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_BUDGET_SET_MON            Return Budget Monitor Reference                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_BUDGET_SET_PPD            Return Budget Monitor Reference                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_MESSAGE_LOG               Return Message Log Object                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_PPD                       Return PPD Reference                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_PPD_ART_SET               Return PPD Material Work Area Reference                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_PPD_HEADER                Return PPD Header Data Reference                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_PPD_PA_SET                Return PPD PA Level Work Area Reference                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_PPD_WA_DIRECTOR           REturn PPD Work Area Reference                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_SEL_SET_ART               Return Worklist Set for Man. PD Reference                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_SEL_SET_MDP               Return Markdown Selection Set Reference                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_SEL_SET_OS                Return Worklist Set Reference for Promotion PPD             .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_SEL_SET_PPD               Return PPD Selection Set Reference                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_BUS_FACTORY         I GET_SEL_SET_PRO               Return Worklist Set Reference for Promotion PPD             .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Update Rel. Header Area Grids during Application Event      .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I CHECK_FOR_POSS_SCREEN_CHANGE  Checks Whether Tabstrip Switch Is Permitted -" Mandatory Fld.
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I COPY_ORGSET_INTO_CLIPBOARD    Copy OrgSet Entries to Clipboard                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I GET_HDR_AREA_SCREEN_TO_DISPLAYReturn Information on Use of Budget Monitor                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I GET_VIEW_INFO_SET             Return Table with Type WRF_PPW_VIEWINFOSET_TTY              .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I GET_VISIBILITY                Return User-Controlled Visibility of Header Area View       .
IF_WRF_PPW_HDR_AREA_VIEW       I SET_ACTIVE_SCREEN             Set Active Subscreen                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_ITM_AREA_VIEW       I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Check and Update Changed Data                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_ITM_AREA_VIEW       I COPY_ITEMS_INTO_CLIPBOARD     Write Selected Items to Clipboard                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_ITM_AREA_VIEW       I REFRESH_VISIBLE_GRID          Update Visible Grid(s)                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_ITM_AREA_VIEW       I SET_WA_LEVEL                  Set GI Level                                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I CLEAR                         Delete All Entries                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I FREE                          Prepare to Reduce Object                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I GET_LINECOUNT                 Return Number of Message Lines                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I GET_LOG_HANDLES               Return Log Handles                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I GET_MESSAGES                  Return Messages                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_MESSAGE_LOG         I HOLD_CURRENT_MESSAGES         Set Indicator. These Entries Are Kept                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_MSGREFRESHFRAMEWORK I REFRESH_MESSAGES              Update Message Log                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_POPUP_VIEW          I GET_SELECTION_RESULT          Returns Results of Possible Selections                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_POPUP_VIEW          I SHOW_DETAIL                   Display Details for Subscreen Area -" Dialog Box            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I ADD_ART_ITEMS                 Add Materials to Existing PPD in Work Area                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I ADD_RELATED_ARTICLES          Add Related Markdown Proposals                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CHANGE_STATUS                 Status Change                                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CHECK_MODIFY_OS_TYPE          Checks Whether Org. Set Type Can Be Changed                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CHECK_OSITEM_DATA             Check Org. Set Item Data (Consistency, Etc.)                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CHECK_OS_DATA                 Check Current Org. Set Header Data                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CHECK_PROMO_PLANTGROUP        Check Plant Group Data                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CONDENSE_OS_DATA              Aggregate Organization Sets                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CONFLICT_CHECK                Conflict Check                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CONVERT_MN_TO_PR              Convert Manual Price Plan to Promotion Price Plan           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I COPY_OS_DATA                  Create Org. Set Copy -" Header and Item                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I CREATE_EMPTY_ROW_FOR_OS       Create a Blank Line for New Org. Set -" Header              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DEACTIVATE_ITEMS              Activate/Deactivate Material Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DEACTIVATE_PPD                Activate/Deactivate All Items in Price Plan                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DELETE_ITEMS                  Delete Items in PPD                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DELETE_OS_DATA                Delete Org. Set -" Header and Item                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DEQUEUE                       Unlock Price Plan                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DISPLAY_PURCHASE_DETAIL       Display Detailed Purchasing Data                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I DISPLAY_SALES_DETAIL          Display Detailed Sales Data                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I ENQUEUE                       Lock Price Plan                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I FREE                          Release Held Resources                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_ART_ITEMS                 Pass On Material List                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_BUDGET_DATA               Return All PPD Budget Data (WRF_PPW_PPDBG)                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_BUDGET_SET                Returns Reference to the Budget Sets for the Price Plan     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_BUDGET_STATUS             Return Budget Status                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_DEVIANT_PRICES            Determine Price Variance Levels                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_HEADER                    Pass On PPD Header Data                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_HEADER_CHANGEBILITY       Return Chagneability of Header Data Fields                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_HEADER_FIELD_EVAL_FOR_OS  Performs Field Evaluation at Header Level for Org. Sets     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_HEADER_FIELD_EVAL_FOR_PLGRExecutes Field Evaluation at Header Level for Site Groups   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_HEADER_FIELD_EVAL_FOR_PRHDPerforms Field Evaluation at Header Level for Promotion Hdr .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_MESSAGES                  Returns Error Messages if Price Plan Is Inconsistent        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_OSFIELDFUNC_ACTIVITY      Return OrgSet Header Field and Funct. Activity Status       .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_OSITEMFIELDFUNC_ACTIVITY  Return OrgSet Item Field and Funct. Activity Status         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_OSITEM_DATA               Org. Set Item Data                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_OSITEM_TEXT               Enrich OS Items with Texts                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_OS_DATA                   Org. Set Header Data                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PA_COUNT                  Return the Number of Price Activation Levels                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PA_ITEMS                  Get PA Items and Material Items for Specified GUIDs         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PLANTGROUP_DIRECTOR       Returns Reference for Plant Group Director                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PRICING_REF               Determine Dependent Material for Pricing Reference Material .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_DISCOUNT            Returns Promotion Discounts                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_HEADER              Return Promotion Header                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_ITEMS               Returns Promotion Items                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_MATERIALPLANT       Return All Material/Plant Data (WALED) for a Promotion      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_PLANTGROUPS         Return All Plant Groups of a Promotion                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PROMO_PLANTS_OF_PLGR      Return All Plants from Plant Groups of a Promotion          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_PR_ASSIGN_MATNR_TO_PLANT  Returns Assignment of Material to Store                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_RELATED_ARTICLES          Determine Related Markdown Proposals                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I GET_STATE                     Return Status Data of Price Plan (in Memento Form)          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I INSERT_MEMENTO                Add Data from Memento to Price Plan                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I IS_CHANGED                    Was the PPD Changed?                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I IS_DISTCHAIN_CHANGABLE        Can the Distribution Chain Be Changed?                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I IS_ENQUEUED                   Is the Price Plan Locked?                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I IS_PPDART_CHANGABLE           Can the PPD Type Be Changed?                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MERGE_PRICELIST_ORGSETS       Merge Several OrgSets with Price Lists to One OrgSet        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_HEADER                 Process Header Data Changes                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_ITEMS                  Pass On Data Changed in View                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_OSITEM_DATA            Pass Changed Org. Set Item Data to PPD                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_OS_DATA                Pass Changed Org. Set Header Data to PPD                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_OS_TYPE                Change Org. Set Type After User Action                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_PROMO_HEADER           Change Promotion Header                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_PROMO_PLANTGROUPS      Insert, Change, and Delete Plant Groups of a Promotion      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I MODIFY_PROMO_PLANTS_OF_PLGR   Insert, Change and Delete Plants in Plant Groups            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I PREPARE_CONV_MN_TO_PR         Prepare Conversion from Manual to Promotion Price Plan      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I PREPARE_COPY_PPD              Prepare to Copy a PPD                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I REFRESH_FROM_STORAGE          Refresh PPD from Storage Medium                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I REFRESH_PPD                   Update PPD Data                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I REORG_ORGSETS                 Delete Orphaned Org. Sets                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I RESET_MD_PROPOSAL             Undo Markdown Proposals                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I REVISE_PROMOTION_ITEMS        Correct Promotions                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I SAVE                          Save PPD on the Database                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I SET_DEVIANT_PRICES_DEL        Select Transferred Items for Alternate Prices for Deletion  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I SET_ORGSET_ID                 Change Org. Sets of Material Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I SET_STATE                     Set PPD Status                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ADAPTER         I SYNC_OS_OSITEM_BY_PLANTGROUP  Synchronization of Org. Set Header and Items with Site Grps .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_BAPI            I CHANGE                        Change Price Plan                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_BAPI            I DELETE                        Set Price Plan to Status "Flagged for Deletion"             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_BAPI            I GET_DETAIL                    Return Detailed Information for a Price Plan                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_BAPI            I UNDELETE                      Price Plan Status "Flagged for Deletion" -" "In Process"    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I ACCUMULATE_PPD_POSITIONS      Calculate and Collect Transferred Markdown Items            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I ADD_ART_ITEMS                 Add Materials                                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I ADD_RELATED_ARTICLES          Add Related Markdown Proposals                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I APPLY_MEMENTO                 Execute Status Change Based on Memento Object               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CANCEL_CALCITEMS              Cancel Conditions                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CHANGE_BUDG_TYPE              Switch Budget Type                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CHANGE_PA_LEVELS              Change the Price Activation Levels                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CHECK_CONSISTENCY             Check Whether Items Are Correct                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CLEAR_BUDGET_VALUES           Clear Budget Values                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CLEAR_DELETION_BUFFER         Deletion of Buffer for Deleted Price Activation Levels      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I CONFLICT_CHECK                Conflict Check                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I DEACTIVATE_ITEMS              Activate/Deactivate Items                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I DELETE_ITEMS                  Delete Items                                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I DEQUEUE                       Unblock Items                                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I DISPLAY_PURCHASE_DETAIL       Display Detailed Purchasing Data                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I DISPLAY_SALES_DETAIL          Display Detailed Sales Data                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I ENQUEUE                       Block Items                                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I FREE                          Empty the Collection Object                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_ARTICLE_HEADER_DATA       Use Header Data from First Copied Material, if Necessary    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_ART_BUDGETS               Return Budgets Associated with a Material                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_ART_ITEMS                 Return Material Items                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_ASSIGNED_ORGSET_IDS       Return Org. Set IDs Assigned to Materials                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_BUDGETS                   Return Budgets Linked to the Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_DEVIANT_PRICES            Determine Price Variance Levels                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_GUIDS_DEVIANT_PRICES      Return GUIDs of Price Variances                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_ITEM_COUNT                Number of Articles                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_MESSAGES                  Returns Error Messages                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_OS_USAGE_COUNT            Number of Usages per Org. Set                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_PA_BUDGETS                Return Budgets Linked to the Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_PA_COUNT                  Number of PA Items                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_PA_ITEMS                  Return PA Items                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_RELATED_ARTICLES          Determine Related Markdown Proposals                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I GET_STATE                     Write Current Status of Attributes to Memento Object        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I IS_REVISED                    Is there at least one post-processed item? 1=Yes / 0=No     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I MODIFY_ITEMS                  Modify Items in PPD                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I REARRANGE_PPD_ITEMS           Redetermination of Data                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I REFRESH_CALCULATION           Clear Buffer of Non-Critical Function Groups in Pricing     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I REFRESH_PPD                   Update PPD Data                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I REVISE_PROMOTION_ITEMS        Correct Promotion Items                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I ROLLBACK                      Rollback                                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I SAVE_CALCULATION              Save Costing Data                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I SET_DEVIANT_PRICES_DEL        Flag Items with Different Prices for Deletion               .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_ITEMS_COLL      I SET_ORGSET_ID                 Change Org. Sets of Material Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I CHECK_DOUBLE_PLANTS           Checks Plant Groups for Duplicate Plants                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I CHECK_PLANTGROUP              Check Plant Group Data                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I COMMIT                        Execute Changes                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I COMPLETE_ART_ITEMS            Add Promotion Data to Article Items                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I DEQUEUE                       Unblock Price Plan                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I ENQUEUE                       Lock Promotion                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I FREE                          Release Held Resources                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_HEADER                    Return Promotion Header                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_ITEMS                     Returns Promotion Items                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_MATERIALPLANT             Returns All Material/Site Data for a Promotion              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_MESSAGES                  Returns Messages About Error Status                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_PLANTGROUPS               Returns All Plant Groups for the Promotion                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_PLANTGROUP_DIRECTOR       Returns Reference for Plant Group Director                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_PLANTS_OF_PLANTGROUPS     Returns All Plants for Plant Groups in a Promotion          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_PROMO_DISCOUNT            Returns Promotion Discounts                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_PR_ASSIGN_MATNR_TO_PLANT  Returns Assignment of Articles to Stores                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I GET_STATE                     Returns the Current (Partial) State of the Object           .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I IS_MATERIALPLANT_PRESENT      Is Material/Site Data Available?                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I IS_PLANTGROUP_PRESENT         Is Site Group Available?                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_HEADER                 Change Promotion Header                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_ITEMS                  Change Promotion Items                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_ITEMS_FROM_MEMENTO     Insert, Change, and Delete Promotion Items from Memento     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_PLANTGROUPS            Insert, Change, and Delete Plant Groups of a Promotion      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_PLANTS_OF_PLANTGROUPS  Insert, Change, and Delete Plants of a Plant Group          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I MODIFY_PROMOHEAD_FROM_PPDHEAD Change the Promotion Header from the Price Plan Header      .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I REFRESH                       Update Promotion                                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I ROLLBACK                      Reject Changes                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_PROMO_ADAPTER   I SAVE                          Save Promotion                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_STORAGE         I CLEAR_PPD_STATE               Remove Price Plan from List or Empty List Completely        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_STORAGE         I DELETE_REJECTED_ITEMS         Save Rejected Markdowns                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_STORAGE         I LOAD                          Load PPD from Medium                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_STORAGE         I REFRESH                       Refresh PPD from Storage Medium                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_PPD_STORAGE         I STORE                         Save PPD on Medium                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_PROTOCOL            I ADD_PROTOCOL_ENTRY            Add Message                                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_PROTOCOL            I DISPLAY_PROTOCOL              Issue Log                                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_PROTOCOL            I FREE                          Free                                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_AREA_VIEW       I GET_SEL_TYPE                  Return Type of Active Selection Area                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I CHANGE_SEL_SET_MEMBERS        Process Selection Set Objects                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I DELETE_SEL_SET_MEMBERS        Delete/Hide Entries                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I FREE                          Remove Object References                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_CHANGE_FUNCTIONS          Delivers Active Processing Functions for Sel. Set Objects   .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_FILTER                    Get Filter Settings                                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_MEMBER_COUNT              Number of Entries                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_SELECTED_ITEMS_COUNT      Returns the Number of Selected Nodes                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_TEXT                      Name of Selection Set                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_TYPE                      Return Type of Content                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I GET_VIEW_MEMBER_LIST          Return Representative Table                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I REFRESH                       Update Content                                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I SELECT_SEL_SET_MEMBERS        Extend / Refresh Element List                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I SET_FILTER                    Set Filter                                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I SET_FILTER_OFF                Deactivate Filter Settings                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I SET_FILTER_ON                 Perform Filtering                                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_SET             I TRANSFER_TO_WA                Pass Elements to Work Area                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I CHANGE_SEL_SET_MEMBERS        Processing Functions for Objects in Selection Set           .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I DELETE_SEL_SET_MEMBERS        Delete Sel. Set Items                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I GET_BUTTON_DROPDOWN           Picking List for Toolbar Buttons                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I GET_TOOLBAR_BUTTONS           Return Buttons for Toolbar                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I HANDLE_FCODE                  Process F Codes                                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I INITIAL_LOAD                  Load Existing Entries Before CHANGED Event                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I REFRESH                       Refresh                                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_SEL_VIEW            I TRANSFER_TO_WA                Transfer to Work Area                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_STATUS_CTRL         I GET_FUNCTION_LIST             Determine List of Menu Functions                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_SUBSCREEN_VIEW      I CHECK_DATA_CHANGED            Update Rel. Header Area Grids (e.g. Appl. Event)            .
IF_WRF_PPW_SUBSCREEN_VIEW      I CHECK_FOR_POSS_VIEW_CHANGE    Checks Whether Can Switch to View (Mandatory Fields)        .
IF_WRF_PPW_SUBSCREEN_VIEW      I COPY_INTO_CLIPBOARD           Copy Data from Subscreens/Tab Pages to Clipboard            .
IF_WRF_PPW_SUBSCREEN_VIEW      I GET_EXT_PROG_INFO             Return Program Name and Screen Number of Ext. Funct. Group  .
IF_WRF_PPW_SUBSCREEN_VIEW      I SET_APPL_MODE                 Set Application Mode for Field Control to Screen            .
IF_WRF_PPW_USRGRP_VIEW         I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check Modified Data -" ALV Grid - REFRESH                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_USRGRP_VIEW         I EXECUTE_SELECTION             Execution of Price Planner Group Selection                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_USRGRP_VIEW         I GET_FIELDFUNC_LIST            Returns Field and Function Classification                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_USRGRP_VIEW         I INIT_US_USRGRP_GRID           Initialization- ALV Grids for Price Planner Group Assignment.
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW                I CALC_EXCLUDING_LIST           Determine Status Active/Inactive/Hidden for Menu Entries    .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW                I CONFIGURE_TOOLBAR             Setup/Update Toolbar                                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW                I FREE                          Dismantle View (Also on Frontend)                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW                I SET_VISIBLE                   Display/Hide Container                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I FREE                          Dismantle Object                                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_BUDGET_DET_VIEW_MON       Returns Budget Detail View Object for Budget Monitor        .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_BUDGET_DET_VIEW_PPD       Returns Budget Detail View Object for PPD Budgets           .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_BUDGET_LIST_VIEW          Return Budget Monitor Object                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_HDR_AREA_VIEW             Return PPW Header Data View Area Instance                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_ITM_VIEW                  Return View for PPD Work Area                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_MESSAGE_LOG_VIEW          Return Message Log View Object                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_SELECTION_VIEW            Return Selection Area Object                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_SEL_TREE_VIEW             Return Selection Tree Object                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_USRGRP_VIEW               Return PPW Price Planner Groups View Object (Type!)         .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_ART_LIST_VIEW          Return PPD Material Item List Object                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_HEADER_VIEW            Return PPD Header Object                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_OSITEM_ORG_VIEW        Return PPW Org. Set Item Data View Object (Type!)           .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_OSITEM_SITEGRP_VIEW    Return PPW Org. Set Item Data View Object (Type!)           .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_OS_VIEW                Return PPW Org. Set Header Data View Object                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_PA_LIST_VIEW           Return PPD Price Activation Level List Object               .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_PROMO_VIEW             Return PPW Promotion-Specific View Object                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WA_SITEGROUP_VIEW         Return PPD Plant Group View (Promotion-Relevant)            .
IF_WRF_PPW_VIEW_FACTORY        I GET_WF_TOOLBOX_VIEW           Return Workflow Toolbox                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_DIRECTOR         I GET_WA_ART_SET                Return PPD_ART_SET Object                                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_DIRECTOR         I GET_WA_HEADER                 Return PPD_Header Object                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_DIRECTOR         I GET_WA_PA_SET                 Return PPD_PA_SET Object                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_DIRECTOR         I LINK_TO_PPD                   Link WA with New PPD Object                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_DIRECTOR         I REFRESH                       Update Work Area                                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_HEADER_VIEW      I GET_HEADER_DATA               Return PPD Header Data                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_HEADER_VIEW      I SET_HEADER_DATA_PAI           Set Header Data After User Input Within Header Screen       .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_LST_VIEW         I COPY_ITEMS_INTO_CLIPBOARD     Write Selected Items to Clipboard                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_LST_VIEW         I GET_OBJECT_REF                Return Reference to Object in View                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_LST_VIEW         I GET_SELECTED_ROWS             Return Lines Selected in View                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_LST_VIEW         I SHOW_SELECTED_ITEMS           Display Data for Selected Items                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I CHECK_CHANGED_DATA            Check Changed OrgSet Item Data -" ALV Grid                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I CHECK_OSITEM_DATA             Check Org. Set Item Data -" PPD                             .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I GET_OSITEM_DATA_PBO           Return OrgSet Item-Rel. Data in PBO to Ext. Funct. Group    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I INIT_OSITEM_GRID              Initialize OrgSet Item Data -" ALV Grid                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I MODIFY_OSITEM_DATA            Pass Change Request for OrgSet Item Data to PPD             .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OSITEM_VIEW      I RETURN_FROM_EXT_SCREEN        Return from External Screen (Dialog Box Ext. Funct. Group)  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OS_VIEW          I GET_OS_DATA_PBO               Transfer -" OrgSet Header Data for Ext. Funct. Group to PBO .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_OS_VIEW          I SET_OS_DATA_PAI               Transfer -" User Inputs for OrgSet View (Header) to PAI     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I CHECK_PROMO_PLANTGROUP        Check Plant Group Data                                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_HEADER_DATA               Pass PPD Header Data to Calling Function Group              .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_FIELD_CLASS         Transfer Promotion Field Control to Calling Function Group  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_HEADER              Pass Promotion Header Data to Calling Function Group        .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_MATERIALPLANT       Return All Material/Plant Data (WALED) for a Promotion      .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_OSITEM_DATA         Delivers Organization Set Item Data for Promotions          .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_PG_FIELD_SEL        Transfer Promotion-Specific Field Control                   .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_PLANTGROUPS         Return All Plant Groups of a Promotion                      .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_PLANTS_OF_PLGR      Returns All Plants from Plant Groups                        .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I GET_SCREEN_CONTROL            Pass Next Screen Control T180 to Calling Function Group     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I HANDLE_FCODE                  Handling of Function Codes                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I MODIFY_PROMO_DATA             Change Promotion Data                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I MODIFY_PROMO_HEADER           Change Promotion Header Data after User Entry on Screen     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAGU_VIEW  I SYNC_OS_OSITEM_BY_PLANTGROUP  Synchronization of Org. Set Header and Items with Site Grps .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAKH_VIEW  I GET_HEADER_DATA               Pass PPD Header Data to Calling Function Group              .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAKH_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_FIELD_CLASS         Transfer Promotion Field Control to Calling Function Group  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAKH_VIEW  I GET_PROMO_HEADER              Pass Promotion Header Data to Calling Function Group        .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_PROMO_WAKH_VIEW  I MODIFY_PROMO_HEADER           Change Promotion Header Data after User Entry on Screen     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I ADD_RELATED_ARTICLES          Add Related Markdown Proposals                              .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I COPY_ITEMS_INTO_CLIPBOARD     Copy Items to Clipboard                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I DEACTIVATE_ITEMS              Activate/Deactivate Material Items                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I DELETE_ITEMS                  Delete Items                                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I DISPLAY_PURCHASE_DETAIL       Display Detailed Purchasing Data                            .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I DISPLAY_SALES_DETAIL          Display Detailed Sales Data                                 .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I FREE                          Remove Object References                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_BUDGET_SET                Returns Reference to the Budget Sets for the Price Plan     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_DEVIANT_PRICES            Return Price Variance                                       .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_HEADER                    Pass On PPD Header Data                                     .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_OS_DATA                   Pass On Org. Set Header Data                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_PA_COUNT                  Return Number of Price Activation Levels                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_PRICING_REF               Determine Dependent Materials                               .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_RELATED_ARTICLES          Return Dependent Markdown Proposals                         .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I GET_WA_SET_TABLE_REF          Get Reference to SET Table                                  .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I LINK_TO_PPD                   Link PPD Areas (Material + PA Set, Header) and PPD          .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I LOAD_ITEMS                    Load PPD Data for Specified Items                           .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I MODIFY_ITEMS                  Pass On Data Changed in View                                .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I RESET_MD_PROPOSAL             Reset Markdown Proposals                                    .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I REVISE_PROMOTION_ITEMS        Correct Promotions                                          .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I SET_DEVIANT_PRICES_DEL        Selects Items with Price Variance for Deletion              .
IF_WRF_PPW_WA_SET              I SET_ORGSET_ID                 Change Org. Set ID                                          .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I COMMIT_LOG_PART               Set messages in status commit_done                          .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I DELETE_LOG_PART               Delete part of log after rollback                           .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I GET_CONTROL                   Read Control Record                                         .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I GET_LOG                       Get message table                                           .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I SET_CONTROL                   Fill Control Record                                         .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I SET_MESSAGE                   Issue Message                                               .
IF_WRF_REF_MESSAGE             I SET_SY_MESSAGE                Issue SY Message                                            .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I ADD_BY_REFERENCE              Add Plant Group to Existing Object Using Reference          .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I ADD_NEW_LOCAL_PLANTGROUP      Add New Plant Group (At Present, Can Only Be Local)         .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I ADD_PLANTGROUP                Add Existing Plant Group (Local or Class)                   .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I ADJUST_PLANTGROUP_NAME        Adjust Plant Group Description                              .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I DELETE_PLANTGROUP             Delete plant group                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I DEREFERENCE                   Convert Plant Group (Classification System -" Local)        .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I GET_PLANTGROUP                Return Plant Group                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I GET_PLANTGROUP_COLLECTION     Return Plant Groups Collection                              .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I GET_PLANTS                    Return Plants from a Plant Group                            .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I GET_PROMO_HEADER              Returns Promotion Header Data                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I SAVE                          Save Plant Groups                                           .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_DIRECTOR      I UPDATE_PROMO_HEADER           Refresh Promotion Header Data                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_PG_LOC_DB     I DELETE_PLANTS                 Delete Plants for Plant Group                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_PG_LOC_DB     I LOAD_PLANTS                   Load Plants for Plant Group                                 .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_PG_LOC_DB     I SAVE_PLANTS                   Save Plants for Plant Group                                 .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_STORAGE       I LOAD_PG                       Read Plant Group Data from Database (WAPG, WAPGT)           .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_STORAGE       I SAVE_PG                       Save Plant Group Data (WAPG, WAPGT)                         .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_VIEW          I GET_CLINT                     Get Class Number                                            .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_VIEW          I GET_TRTYP                     Get Transaction Type                                        .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_VIEW          I SET_PLANTS_SORT_ORDER         Defines the sort order for displaying plants info on screen .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_VIEW          I SET_TRTYP                     Communicate Transaction Type                                .
IF_WRF_RPR_IPGRP_VIEW          I SHOW_MAIN_SCREEN              Display Detail Screen for Plant Group                       .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I ADD_ARTICLE                   Add Material                                                .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I ADD_PLANT                     Add Plant to a Plant Group                                  .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I ADD_PLANTGROUP                Add Plant Group                                             .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I CHECK_PLANTGROUP              Check Consistency of Plant Groups                           .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I COMMIT                        Commit to Intermediate State                                .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I DELETE_ARTICLE                Delete material                                             .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I DELETE_PLANT                  Delete Plant from Plant Group                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I DELETE_PLANTGROUP             Delete plant group                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I DEQUEUE                       move Promotion from Queue                                   .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I ENQUEUE                       Include Promotion in Queue                                  .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I FREE                          Reset Tables and References                                 .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_ARTICLEPLANTS             Return Assignment of Materials to Plants                    .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_ARTICLES                  Return All Materials                                        .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_DB_STATE_TABLES           Return All Data in Database State                           .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_HEADER                    Return Header Data                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_MEMENTO                   Return Promotion Memento Reference                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_PLANTGROUPS               Return All Plant Groups                                     .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_PLANTGROUP_DIR            Return Plant Group Manager                                  .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_PLANTS                    Return Plants from Certain Plant Groups                     .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_PROMO_DESCRIPTION         Return Promotion Descriptions                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_PROMO_DISCOUNTS           Return All Promotion Discounts                              .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I GET_THEMES                    Return All Themes                                           .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I IS_ARCHIVED                   Return 'X' for Promo. Loaded from Archive, Otherwise SPACE  .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I IS_EXPIRED                    Return 'X' if End Date Earlier than Current Date (SY-DATLO) .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I REFRESH_FROM_CLONE            Copy Data from Promotion Object Transferred                 .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I ROLLBACK                      Reset to Work State                                         .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I SET_ARTICLE                   Change Material                                             .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I SET_DB_STATE_ON_SAVE          Reset Database State to Work State                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I SET_HEADER                    Change Header Data                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I SET_PLANT                     Change Plant in a Plant Group                               .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMOTION           I SET_PLANTGROUP                Change Plant Group                                          .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMO_MEMENTO       I GET_TABLES                    Return Data Tables and Structures                           .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMO_STORAGE       I LOAD                          Load Promotion from Database or Archive                     .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMO_STORAGE       I REFRESH                       Reload Promotion                                            .
IF_WRF_RPR_PROMO_STORAGE       I SAVE                          Save Promotion in Database                                  .
IF_WRF_WLAY_X_AR_AV_X          I TRANSPORT                     Transfer the Changed Versions                               .
IF_WRF_WLAY_X_WLMMN_E          I GET_TWML                      Returns Selected Layout Modules                             .
IF_WRF_WLAY_X_WLMMN_E          I START_WITH_SELECTION          Transaction Start with Selection                            .
IF_WRITER_MM                   I WRITE_INTEGER                 Write Integer                                               .
IF_WRITER_MM                   I WRITE_OBJECT                  Write Object                                                .
IF_WRITER_MM                   I WRITE_ROOT                    Write Root                                                  .
IF_WRITER_MM                   I WRITE_STRING                  Write String                                                .
IF_WSPROTOCOL_XI_HEADER        I GET_HEADER_FIELD              Reads Value from XI Message Header (in String Representn)   .
IF_WS_ACKNOWLEDGMENT           I GET_ACK_REQUEST               Gets the Ack requests of the application message            .
IF_WS_ACKNOWLEDGMENT           I GET_STATUS                    Read Status Information                                     .
IF_WS_ACKNOWLEDGMENT           I GET_STATUS_DETAIL             Detailed Ack Tree                                           .
IF_WS_ACKNOWLEDGMENT           I GET_STATUS_TREE               Aggregated Ack Tree                                         .
IF_WS_IDP_ACCESS               I RETRIEVE                      List Business Documents from DB                             .
IF_WS_IDP_ACCESS               I SAVE                          Saves Business Documents                                    .
IF_WS_IDP_HELPER               I IS_MESSAGE_PROCESSED          Checks whether business document already processed          .
IF_WS_IDP_HELPER               I RETRIEVE                      Gets Business Document from DB                              .
IF_WS_IDP_HELPER               I SAVE                          Saves Business Document                                     .
IF_WS_MD_LOCKABLE_OBJECT       I GET_CORR_INSERT               Get Configuration for RS_CORR_INSERT                        .
IF_WS_MD_LOCKABLE_OBJECT       I SET_CORR_INSERT               Set Configuration for RS_CORR_INSERT                        .
IF_WS_MD_VIF                   I GET_PROXY_VERSION             Proxy Version of Generated Classes                          .
IF_WS_MD_VIF                   I SET_CONSTRUCTOR_SOURCE        Set source code of generated constructor                    .
IF_WS_MD_VIF                   I SET_PROXY_METHOD_SOURCE       Set source code of generated get_proxy method               .
IF_WS_MD_VIF                   I SET_PROXY_VERSION             Proxy Version of Generated Classes                          .
IF_WS_MD_VIF_ENDPOINT_REF      I GET_SERVICE_DEF_STARTPOINT_RAWReturn Unprocessed (Processed Return via Plug-In)           .
IF_WS_MD_VIF_ENDPOINT_REF      I IS_AUTO_GENERATED             Was the Service Definition Generated Automatically?         .
IF_WS_MD_VIF_STRUC_TYPE        I GET_PARAM_IDS_FOR_ST_CALL     Return all Parameter IDs +  related ones for a ST call      .
IF_WS_MD_VIF_STRUC_TYPE        I GET_PARAM_IDS_FOR_ST_GEN      Return all Parameter IDs needed for an ST generation        .
IF_WS_MD_VIF_STRUC_TYPE        I RESET                         deletes all fields of this and of copied types              .
IF_WS_MD_WSD                   I SET_PROFILE                   Sets the Features/Properties According to Specified Profile .
IF_WS_MD_WSDL_VIEW             I GET_WSDL                      WSDL Description of Object                                  .
IF_WS_MD_WSD_SOAP_APPL         I GET_KEY                       Provides Key                                                .
IF_WS_MD_WSD_SOAP_APPL         I SET_PROFILE                   Sets the Features/Properties According to Specified Profile .
IF_WS_PAYLOAD                  I GET_XML_TEXT                  XML in Text Format                                          .
IF_WS_PRE_ROUTING              I RECEIVERS_EXIST               Determine Whether Potential Receivers Exist                 .
IF_WS_SECURITY_PROFILE         I APPLY                         Create the Security Header (Outbound Calls)                 .
IF_WS_SECURITY_PROFILE         I VERIFY                        Check the Security Header (Inbound Calls)                   .
IF_WS_SECURITY_PROTOCOL        I POST_FILTER                   Filter SOAP Message After Request                           .
IF_WS_SECURITY_PROTOCOL        I PRE_FILTER                    Filter SOAP Message Before Request                          .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I DELETE_TAXONOMY_FOR_GRP_OBJ   Delete a Taxonomy for a Service Object in a Group           .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I DELETE_TAXONOMY_FOR_SRV_OBJ   Delete a Taxonomy                                           .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I GET_TAXONOMIES_FOR_GRP_OBJ    Get Taxonomy data for Service Objects in a group/tbd        .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I GET_TAXONOMIES_FOR_SRV_OBJ    Get Taxonomy names and values                               .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I GET_TAXONOMY_FOR_GRP_OBJ      Get a single taxonomy for a Service Object in a Group       .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I GET_TAXONOMY_FOR_SRV_OBJ      Get a single taxonomy                                       .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I SET_TAXONOMY_FOR_GRP_OBJ      Create/Change/Overwrite a Taxonomy for Service Object in Grp.
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I SET_TAXONOMY_FOR_SRV_OBJ      Create/Change/Overwrite a Taxonomy                          .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I TAXONOMY_FOR_GRP_OBJ_EXISTS   Check whether a taxonomy  for Service Object in Group exists.
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_INST          I TAXONOMY_FOR_SRV_OBJ_EXISTS   Check whether a taxonomy exists                             .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I DELETE_CLASSIFICATIONS        Deletes given or all classifications of a SD                .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I GET_CLASS_FOR_SERVICE_OBJECT  Get classification names and values for SD                  .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I GET_PUBLICATION_TIMESTAMP     gets the publication timestamp for sd or config             .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I GET_SD_STATUS                 Returns StatusInfos for Service Definitions                 .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I GET_USED_CLASS_SYSTEMS        Returns all currently used Classification Systems           .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I GET_USED_CLASS_VALUES         Returns all currently used Classification Systems Values    .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I QUERY_SERVICE_OBJECTS         Query Service Objects by different Search criteria          .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I SET_CLASS_FOR_SERVICE_OBS     Set classification for different Service Objects            .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I SET_CLASS_VIA_FILE_IMPORT     Set classifications via file Import                         .
IF_WS_UDDI_CLASS_STATIC        I SET_PUBLICATION_TIMESTAMP     sets the publication timestamp for sd or config             .
IF_WTY_CUST_BUFFERED_OBJ_CNTL  I CREATE_INSTANCE               Creates Instance of External Buffered Object                .
IF_WTY_EXT_OBJECT_CNTL         I CREATE_INSTANCE               Creates Instance of External Buffered Object                .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I BUTTONGROUP_CLICK             "xhtmlb:buttonGroup" onClick                                .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I BUTTONGROUP_TOGGLE            "xhtmlb:buttonGroup" onToggle                               .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TABSTRIP_EDIT                 "xhtmlb:tabStrip" onEdit                                    .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TABSTRIP_HELP                 "xhtmlb:tabStrip" onHelp                                    .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TABSTRIP_REMOVE               "xhtmlb:tabStrip" onRemove                                  .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TABSTRIP_SELECT               "xhtmlb:tabStrip" onSelect                                  .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TABSTRIP_VIEWSTATE            "xhtmlb:tabStrip" onViewState                               .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TOOLBARBUTTON_CLICK           "xhtmlb:toolbarBotton" onClick                              .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TOOLBARDDLB_SELECT            "xhtmlb:toolbarDDLB" onSelect                               .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TOOLBARLINK_CLICK             "xhtmlb:toolbarLink" onClick                                .
IF_XHTMLB_EVENTS               I TOOLBAR_LAYER_SELECT          "xhtmlb:toolbar" onLayerSelect                              .
IF_XMB_ERROR_MONITOR           I DELETE_ERROR                  Delete All Error Objects for Specified Message              .
IF_XMB_ERROR_MONITOR           I REPORT_ERROR                  AI - Report Error to Monitoring Architecture                .
IF_XMB_RUNTIME_MONITOR         I MESSAGE_COMPLETED             End of Message Object Processing                            .
IF_XMB_RUNTIME_MONITOR         I MESSAGE_STARTED               Start of Message Object Processing                          .
IF_XML_DOCUMENT_POC            I GET_DIALOG_SERVICE            Instance for Dialog Service                                 .
IF_XML_DOCUMENT_POC            I GET_LANGUAGE                  Query Language of Document                                  .
IF_XML_DOCUMENT_POC            I GET_RESOURCE                  Query Resource                                              .
IF_XML_DOCUMENT_POC            I GET_SIGNATURE_SERVICE         Instance for Signature Service                              .
IF_XML_DOCUMENT_POC            I SYNCHRONIZE                   Synchronize                                                 .
IF_XML_SCHEMA                  I ADD_COMPLEX_TYPE              Add XSD Complex Type                                        .
IF_XML_SCHEMA                  I ADD_ELEMENT                   Add XSD Element                                             .
IF_XML_SCHEMA                  I ADD_RESTRICTION               Add Restrictions to Simple/Complex Type                     .
IF_XML_SCHEMA                  I ADD_SCHEMA_REF                Add Reference to External Schema                            .
IF_XML_SCHEMA                  I ADD_SIMPLE_TYPE               Add XSD Simple Type                                         .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_EDIT_COMMENT          Gets XML for Dialog: Enter Comment                          .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_INFO_DEVIATION        Gets XML for Dialog: Deviation Occurred                     .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_SHOW_COMMENTS         Gets XML for Dialog: Display Comments                       .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_SHOW_DEVIATIONS       Gets XML for Dialog: Deviation History                      .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_SHOW_MESSAGE          Gets XML for Dialog: Message Data                           .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_SHOW_PROPERTIES       Gets XML for Dialog: Properties                             .
IF_XML_SRV_DIALOG_POC          I GET_XML_SHOW_SIGNATURES       Gets XML for Dialog: Signatures Executed                    .
IF_XML_SRV_SIGNATURE_POC       I GET_CONFIRMATION_DOC          XML Document for Process Step                               .
IF_XML_SRV_SIGNATURE_POC       I GET_DEVIATION_DOC             XML Document for Deviations                                 .
IF_XML_SRV_SIGNATURE_POC       I GET_EVENT_DOC                 XML Document for Event Log                                  .
IF_XMS_ADAPTER                 I GET_ADAPTER_STATUS            Gets Adapter Status                                         .
IF_XMS_ENGINE                  I ENTER_ENGINE                  Integration Engine Call                                     .
IF_XMS_FACTORY                 I CREATEMESSAGEFACTORY          Generates a Message Factory                                 .
IF_XMS_FACTORY                 I CREATEMESSAGEREGISTRY         Generates a Message Registry                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I ADDATTACHMENT                 Appends Resource                                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I ADDBODY                       Sets Body Property                                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I ADDHEADER                     Sets Header Property                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I CLEARATTACHMENTS              Deletes All Attachment Resources                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I CLEARBODIES                   Deletes All Body Properties                                 .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I CLEARHEADERS                  Deletes All Header Properties                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEATTACHMENTATINDEX       Deletes Attachment Resource with Index                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEATTACHMENTBYNAME        Deletes Attachment Resource with Name                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEBODYATINDEX             Deletes Body Property with Index                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEBODYBYNAME              Deletes Body Property with Name                             .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEHEADERATINDEX           Deletes Header Property with Index                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I DELETEHEADERBYNAME            Deletes Header Property with Name                           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETATTACHMENTATINDEX          Gets Attachment with Index                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETATTACHMENTBYNAME           Gets Attachment with Name                                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETATTACHMENTS                Gets Number of Attachment Resources                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETATTACHMENTSBYTYPE          Gets Type Attachments                                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETBODIES                     Gets All Body Properties                                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETBODYATINDEX                Gets Body Property with Index                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETBODYBYNAME                 Gets Body Property with Name                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETBODYNSCONTEXT              Gets Namespace Context for Body Part                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETHEADERATINDEX              Get Header Property with Index                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETHEADERBYNAME               Gets Header Property with Name                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETHEADERNSCONTEXT            Gets Namespace Context for Header Part                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I GETHEADERS                    Gets All Header Properties                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I INSERTATTACHMENT              Inserts Resource into Index                                 .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I INSERTBODY                    Inserts Body Property                                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I INSERTHEADER                  Inserts Header Property                                     .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I NUMBEROFATTACHMENTS           Gets Number of Attachment Resources                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I NUMBEROFBODIES                Gets Number of Body Properties                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I NUMBEROFHEADERS               Gets Number of Header Properties                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I REPLACEHEADER                 Replaces Header Property                                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I SETBODYNSCONTEXT              Sets Namespace Context for Body Part                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE                 I SETHEADERNSCONTEXT            Sets Namespace Context for Header Part                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATEBINARYRESOURCE          Generates a Binary Resource Object                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATEBLOBRESOURCE            Generates a Blob Resource Object                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATEMESSAGE                 Generates a Message Object                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATENSCONTEXT               Generates a Namespace Context                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATEPROPERTY                Generates a Property Instance                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATETEXTRESOURCE            Generates a Text Resource Object                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_FACTORY         I CREATEXMLSOURCE               Generates an XML Source                                     .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I DELETEPROPERTYIMPL            Deletes the Property Implementation Registration            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I DELETERESOURCEIMPL            Deletes Resource Implementation Registration                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I GETPROPERTYIMPL               Gets the Implementation of IF_XMS_PROP                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I GETPROPERTYIMPLS              Gets All Property Implementation Registrations              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I GETRESOURCEIMPL               Fetches Implementation of IF_XMS_RESOURCE                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I GETRESOURCEIMPLS              Fetches All Resource Implementation Registrations           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I SETPROPERTYIMPL               Sets the Implementation of IF_XMS_PROP                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_REGISTRY        I SETRESOURCEIMPL               Sets Implementation of IF_XMS_RESOURCE                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_RUN             I COPY                          Copy Message Object                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_TRANSFER        I DELETE_GROUP                  Signalizes that a group is to be deleted                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_TRANSFER        I DETERMINE_RFC_DEST            Determine RFC Destination                                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_TRANSFER        I FINALIZE_MESSAGE_TRANSFER     Signalizes that there will be no further messages           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_TRANSFER        I START_MESSAGE_TRANSFER        Initiates Transfer Process                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I ADD_RECEIVER                  Add Receiver                                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I APPEND_TO_MMF                 Add Message to AMF Object                                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I CLEAR_RECEIVERS               List of Receivers                                           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I DELETE_RECEIVER               Delete Receiver                                             .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_APP_ACK_REQ               Read Application Confirmation Request                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_APP_ERR_ACK_REQ           Read Application Error Confirmation Request                 .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_CONVERSATION_ID           Read Conversation ID                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_DIRECTION                 To be deleted: Use MessageClass instead                     .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_DYNAMIC_HEADER            Read Dynamic Header                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_FAULT                     Read Application Error Key                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_INBOUND_BINDING           Read Sender Agreement                                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_INTERFACE                 Read Interface                                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MAIN_PAYLOADS             Read Main Payloads                                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_CLASS             Read Message Class                                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_FORMAT            Read Messsage Format                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_HANDLE_INBOUND    Read Message Handle (Inbound)                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_HANDLE_OUTBOUND   Read Message Handle (Outbound)                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_ID                Read Message ID                                             .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_MESSAGE_SIZE_TOTAL        Estimated Message Size                                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_NOT_IN_ORDER_RECEIVERS    Read receiver whose sequence is not relevant                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_OUTBOUND_BINDING          Read Receiver Agreement                                     .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_PROCESSING_MODE           Read Processing Type                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_QUALITY_OF_SERVICE        Read QoS                                                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_QUEUE_ID                  Read Queue ID                                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_RECEIVER                  Read Receiver                                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_RECEIVERS                 Read Receiver List                                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_REF_TO_MESSAGE_ID         Read Message ID Reference                                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_SENDER                    Read Sender                                                 .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_SKIP_RECV_DETERMINATION   Read Skip Receiver Determination Property                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_SYS_ACK_REQ               Read System Confirmation Request                            .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_SYS_ERR_ACK_REQ           Read System Error Confirmation Request                      .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_TIME_SENT                 Read Send Time Stamp                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I GET_VERSION                   Read Message Format/Protocol Version                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I INSERT_RECEIVER               Insert Receiver                                             .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I NUMBER_OF_RECEIVERS           Number of Receivers                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_APP_ACK_REQ               Set Application Confirmation Request                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_APP_ERR_ACK_REQ           Set Application Error Confirmation Request                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_CONVERSATION_ID           Set Conversation ID                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_FAULT                     Set Application Error Key                                   .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_INBOUND_BINDING           Set Sender Agreement                                        .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_INTERFACE                 Set Interface                                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_MESSAGE_CLASS             Set Message Class                                           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_MESSAGE_FORMAT            Set Message Format                                          .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_MESSAGE_HANDLE_INBOUND    Set Message Handle (Inbound)                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_MESSAGE_HANDLE_OUTBOUND   Set Message Handle (Outbound)                               .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_MESSAGE_ID                Set Message ID                                              .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_NOT_IN_ORDER_RECEIVERS    Set receiver whose sequence is not relevant                 .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_PROCESSING_MODE           Set Processing Type                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_QUALITY_OF_SERVICE        Set QoS                                                     .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_QUEUE_ID                  Set Queue ID                                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_RECEIVER                  Set Receiver                                                .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_RECEIVERS                 Set Receiver List                                           .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_REF_TO_MESSAGE_ID         Set Message ID Reference                                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_SENDER                    Set Sender                                                  .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_SKIP_RECV_DETERMINATION   Set Skip Receiver Determination Property                    .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_SYS_ACK_REQ               Set System Confirmation Request                             .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_SYS_ERR_ACK_REQ           Set System Error Confirmation Request                       .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_TIME_SENT                 Set Send Time Stamp                                         .
IF_XMS_MESSAGE_XMB             I SET_VERSION                   Set Message Format/Protocol Version                         .
IF_XMS_MONITOR                 I DISPLAY_MESSAGE               Display Message                                             .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I ADD_RECORD                    Add a Data Record                                           .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I GET_MATCHED_RECORDS           Gets All Data Records for a Specific Namespace              .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I GET_NUMBER_OF_RECORDS         Gets the Current Number of Data Records                     .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I GET_RECORD                    Gets One Data Record                                        .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I GET_RECORDS                   Gets All Data Records (Name/Value)                          .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I REMOVE_MATCHED_RECORDS        Deletes All Data Records for a Specific Namespace           .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I REMOVE_RECORDS                Deletes All Data Records                                    .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_DYNAMIC        I SET_RECORDS                   Sets Attribute for Dynamic Configuration Table              .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I ADD_RECORD                    Add a Data Record                                           .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I GET_MATCHED_RECORDS           Gets All Data Records for a Specific Namespace              .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I GET_NUMBER_OF_RECORDS         Gets the Current Number of Data Records                     .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I GET_RECORD                    Gets One Data Record                                        .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I GET_RECORDS                   Gets All Data Records (Name/Value)                          .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I REMOVE_MATCHED_RECORDS        Deletes All Data Records for a Specific Namespace           .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I REMOVE_RECORDS                Deletes All Data Records                                    .
IF_XMS_MSGHDR30_SYSTEM         I SET_RECORDS                   Sets attribute system header table                          .
IF_XMS_MSG_TRANSFER_FINISHED   I MESSAGES_WERE_TRANSFERRED     Signalizes successful message transfer                      .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I ADDBODYPART                   Adds a Data Part to this Multipart                          .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I GETBODYPART                   Returns the Specified Data Part                             .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I GETBOUNDARY                   Returns Boundary String                                     .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I GETCOUNT                      Returns the Number of Data Parts                            .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I READFROM                      Sets the Contents from Binary String                        .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I REMOVEBODYPART                Deletes Specified Data Part                                 .
IF_XMS_MULTIPART               I WRITETO                       Gives Content (inc. All Subcomponents) as a Binary String   .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I CLEARBINDINGS                 Deletes All Bindings                                        .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I FREEZE                        Freezes Status                                              .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I GETBINDINGS                   Gets All Bindings                                           .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I ISFROZEN                      Gets Temperature                                            .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I MAPPREFIXTOURI                Gets the URI for the Prefix                                 .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I MAPURITOPREFIX                Gets the Prefix for the URI                                 .
IF_XMS_NSCONTEXT               I SETBINDING                    Sets the Namespace Prefix URI Binding                       .
IF_XMS_PARSER                  I APPEND_XML_ITEM               Generate XML Tag                                            .
IF_XMS_PARSER                  I GET_NEXT_XML_ITEM             Read next XML element  (Post-Order)                         .
IF_XMS_PARSER                  I INITIALIZE                    Initialize Parser                                           .
IF_XMS_PARSER                  I RENDER_SAP_HEADER             Render SAP Header                                           .
IF_XMS_PARSER                  I SET_NAMESPACE_BINDING         Set assignment (namespace, URI)                             .
IF_XMS_PART                    I ADDHEADER                     Adds Value of the Existing Values for Header Name           .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETALLHEADERS                 Gives All Header Values in Name Value Table                 .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETBINARYCONTENT              Returns Content as a Binary String (if possible)            .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETCHARSET                    Returns Charset                                             .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETCONTENTTYPE                Returns Content Type (Mime Type) of Contents                .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETCONTENTTYPEPARAMS          Gets Parameters of Content Type as Name Value Table         .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETDESCRIPTION                Describes this Data Part                                    .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETHEADER                     Returns All Header Values for the Specified Name            .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETKIND                       Returns Type (Text, Binary, Multipart)                      .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETMIMETYPE                   Returns MIME Type                                           .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETMULTIPARTCONTENT           Returns the Contents as a Multipart Object (if possible)    .
IF_XMS_PART                    I GETTEXTCONTENT                Returns the Contents as a Text String (if possible)         .
IF_XMS_PART                    I READFROM                      Sets the Part from Binary String                            .
IF_XMS_PART                    I READFROMCOMPONENTS            Sets the Part from Components                               .
IF_XMS_PART                    I REMOVEALLHEADERS              Deletes All Header Values of this Part                      .
IF_XMS_PART                    I REMOVEHEADER                  Deletes All Header Values of this Name                      .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETBINARYCONTENT              Sets Specified Binary String as Contents                    .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETDESCRIPTION                Sets a Name for this Data Part                              .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETHEADER                     Sets the Value for the Specified Header Name                .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETMULTIPARTCONTENT           Sets the Specified Multipart Object as Contents             .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETRAWCONTENT                 Sets Contents                                               .
IF_XMS_PART                    I SETTEXTCONTENT                Sets the Specified Text String as Contents                  .
IF_XMS_PART                    I WRITECONTENTTO                Gives Content (inc. All Subcomponents) as a Binary String   .
IF_XMS_PART                    I WRITETO                       Gives the Part (inc. All Subcomponents) as a Binary String  .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETBINARYCONTENT              Gets Binary Content (For All TYPE)                          .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETBLOBCONTENT                Gets Blob Content (For All TYPE)                            .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETCONTENTTYPE                Gets Content Type (MIME)                                    .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETDATA                       Gets Attachment                                             .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETDESCRIPTION                Read Payload Description                                    .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETDOCUMENTNAME               Gets Document Name                                          .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETLOCATION                   Gets Location (xlink:href)                                  .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETPAYLOADTYPE                Read Payload Type                                           .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETREFERENCE                  Gets Reference                                              .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETTEXTCONTENT                Fetches Text Content (If TYPE = 'T')                        .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I GETTYPE                       Gets Payload Type                                           .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I ISAPPLICATIONPAYLOAD          Gets 'X' for application payload; '' for others             .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETBINARYCONTENT              Sets Binary Content                                         .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETBLOBCONTENT                Sets Blob Content                                           .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETDATA                       Sets Attachment                                             .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETDESCRIPTION                Set Payload Description                                     .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETDOCUMENTNAME               Sets Document Name                                          .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETLOCATION                   Sets Location (xlink:href)                                  .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETPAYLOADTYPE                Set Payload Type                                            .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETREFERENCE                  Sets Reference                                              .
IF_XMS_PAYLOAD                 I SETTEXTCONTENT                Sets Text Content                                           .
IF_XMS_PERSIST                 I INSERT_MESSAGE                Generate message (version) in persistence                   .
IF_XMS_PERSIST                 I READ_MESSAGE                  Read message from persistence                               .
IF_XMS_PERSIST                 I SET_ADAPTER_STATUS            Set adapter status                                          .
IF_XMS_PERSIST                 I SET_MESSAGE_STATUS            Set message status                                          .
IF_XMS_PERSIST                 I SET_QUEUE_INFO                Set Queue Information                                       .
IF_XMS_PLSRV                   I ENTER_PLSRV                   Call for a Message to Be Processed by the Integion Engine   .
IF_XMS_PROFILE                 I GETNAME                       Gets the Name (URI) of the Profile Scheme                   .
IF_XMS_PROFILE                 I PARSE                         Parses the External Message as an Internal Message          .
IF_XMS_PROFILE                 I SERIALIZE                     Serializes the Internal Message as an External Message      .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I GETLOCALNAME                  Gets the Local Name of the Property                         .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I GETMUSTUNDERSTAND             Gets the Value of the "Must Understand" Flag                .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I GETNAMESPACEURI               Gets the Namespace URI of the Property                      .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I ISEXTERNAL                    Should the Header Appear in External Message Format?        .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I READFROMXMLSOURCE             Initializes Object from XML Source                          .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I SETLOCALNAME                  Sets the Local Name of the Property                         .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I SETMUSTUNDERSTAND             Sets the Value of the "Must Understand" Flag                .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I SETNAMESPACEURI               Sets the Namespace URI of the Property                      .
IF_XMS_PROP                    I WRITETOXMLSTRING              Serializes Object as an XML String                          .
IF_XMS_PROP_TEMPLATE           I GET_ATTRIBUTE1                Reading Attribute Value 1                                   .
IF_XMS_PROP_TEMPLATE           I GET_ATTRIBUTE2                Reading Attribute Value 2                                   .
IF_XMS_PROP_TEMPLATE           I SET_ATTRIBUTE1                Setting Attribute Value 1                                   .
IF_XMS_PROP_TEMPLATE           I SET_ATTRIBUTE2                Setting Attribute Value 2                                   .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I GETBINARYDATA                 Gets Data as Binary String                                  .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I GETBLOBDATA                   Gets Data as Blob String                                    .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I GETKIND                       Gets the Type of Data (T or B)                              .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I GETTEXTDATA                   Gets Data for Kind = TEXTRESOURCE                           .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I GETTYPE                       Gets Content Type of Resource                               .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I SETBINARYDATA                 Sets Data as Binary String                                  .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I SETBLOBDATA                   Sets Data as Blob String                                    .
IF_XMS_RESOURCE                I SETTEXTDATA                   Sets Data for Kind = TEXTRESOURCE                           .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I CLEAR                         Reset Error Code                                            .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I GET_ERROR_CODE                Reading Error Code                                          .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I GET_ERROR_CODE_CONTEXT        Reading Error Code Context                                  .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I GET_ERROR_TEXT                Reading Error Text                                          .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I GET_RETRY                     Reading flag, indicating whether to attempt to restart      .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I LOOK_UP_ERROR_TEXT            Reading Error Text for Code                                 .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_ERROR_CODE                Setting Error Code                                          .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_ERROR_CODE_CONTEXT        Setting Error Code Context                                  .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_ERROR_TEXT                Setting Error Text                                          .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_PARAMETER_VALUES          Insert Parameter Value in Error Text                        .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_RETRY                     Setting flag, indicating whether to attempt to restart      .
IF_XMS_SYSTEM_ERROR            I SET_SYSTEM_ERROR              Set System Error                                            .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I APPEND                        Append Trace String to Existing Trace                       .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I CLEAR                         Reset Trace Contents                                        .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ENTERFUNC                     Trace Entry to Enter a Method                               .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ENTERFUNCBEGIN                Trace Entry for Method Call: Start                          .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ENTERFUNCEND                  Trace Entry for Method Call: End                            .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ERROR                         Write Trace Entry for System Error                          .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ERRORSTANDARD                 Trace Entry to Cancel XMB due to a System Error             .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I EXITFUNC                      Trace Entry to Exit a Method                                .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I GETCOPY                       Gets Copy of Trace Object                                   .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I GETTRACE                      Read Trace String                                           .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I GETTRACELEVEL                 Gets Trace Level                                            .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I GET_LENGTH                    Determine Trace Length                                      .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I GET_MESSAGE_ID                Read Message ID                                             .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I INSERTTRACE                   Insert Return-Trace in Current Trace                        .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I ISEMPTY                       Informs if Trace is Empty                                   .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I PLSRVBEGIN                    Trace Entry to Begin Processing a PL Service                .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I PLSRVEND                      Trace Entry to End Processing of a PL Service               .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I SETTRACE                      Set Trace String                                            .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I SETTRACELEVEL                 Sets Trace Level                                            .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I SET_MESSAGE_ID_BY_MO          Set Message ID                                              .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I SYSTEMINFO                    Trace Information About Current System                      .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I TIMESTAMP                     Write Time Stamp in Trace                                   .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I TODO                          Write Trace Entry for ToDo                                  .
IF_XMS_TRACE                   I TRACE                         Write Trace Entry                                           .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I GETELEMENT                    Gets Contents as DOM Element                                .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I GETREADER                     Reads Contents as XML Reader                                .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I GETSTRING                     Gets Contents as String                                     .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I SETELEMENT                    Sets Contents as DOM Element                                .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I SETREADER                     Sets Contents as XML Reader                                 .
IF_XMS_XMLSOURCE               I SETSTRING                     Sets Contents as String                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I ADD_INTERNAL_MESSAGE          Inserts Message                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_CALENDAR_SETUP            Delivers Date Specifications for Generation of Calendar     .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_CALENDAR_WEEK             Get Calendar Week for Key Date                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_EMPLOYEE                  Gets Current Personnel Number                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_INPUT_CONVERTER           Delivers Version-Specific Converter                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_MESSAGE                   Get Messages of Message Handler                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_MESSAGES                  Get Messages of Message Handler                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_PERIOD_INFO               Delivers Calendar Information for a Particular Period       .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_SCENARIO                  Gets Current Scenario                                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I GET_VALUE_HELP_MGR            Delivers Manager for Search Help                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_CORE    I HAS_WORKLIST                  Gets Current Worklist Profile                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_RFC     I GET_CORE                      Get Reference to Application Core                           .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_RFC     I GET_UIA_OBJECT                Delivers UIA Object for a Node ID                           .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_RFC     I HANDLE_EVENT                  Processes Web Dynpro Event                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_UIA     I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Synchronous Message Processing                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_APPLICATION_UIA     I POST_MESSAGE                  Asynchronous Message Processing                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I GET_CELL_TYPE                 Delivers Cell Type                                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I GET_IS_APPR_SUM_CELL          Is Cell the Totals Cell for Approval?                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I GET_NAME                      Gets Name of Cell = Field Name of Working Time              .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I GET_VALUE                     Gets Cell Value                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I HAS_CHANGED                   Has Cell Changed Since Last Time Point?                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I IS_INPUT_CELL                 Is it an input cell?                                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I IS_MODIFYABLE_CELL            Is cell modifiable, even if read-only?                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I IS_READ_ONLY                  Can cell be changed?                                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I IS_TEXT_CELL                  Text Cell -" Cannot Be Changed via Grid                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I REFRESH                       Reset Change Indicator -" Synchronous with BL               .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I RESET_READ_ONLY               Resets Cell to Input Mode                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_APPR_VALUE                Set Text Value from Approval                                .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_IS_APPR_SUM_CELL          Flags a Cell as Approval Totals Cell                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_READ_ONLY_MODE            Sets Cell to Display Mode                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_TEMPLATE_VALUE            Set Value from Template                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_TEXT_VALUE                Set Text Value                                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_USER_INPUT                Sets Value                                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL                I SET_VALUE_BY_WORKLIST         Specical Handling of Worklist                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I GET_CELL_CONTEXT_TIME_RECORD  Delivers Context for Cells Pointing to a Working Time       .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I GET_CELL_CONTEX_TIME_RECORD   Delivers Context for Cells Pointing to a Working Time       .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I GET_CELL_TYPE                 Delivers Cell Type (= Column Type)                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I GET_IS_APPR_SUM_CELL          Is Cell a Totals Cell for Approval?                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I GET_XY_COORDINATES            Delivers Item in Time Sheet                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT        I IS_READ_ONLY                  Is the Cell Display Only?                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT_TR     I GET_TIME_RECORD_ID            Delivers Working Time ID                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT_TR     I HAS_DETAIL                    Does Detailed Info About Working Time Exist?                .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT_TR     I HAS_ERRORS                    Does the Working Time Have Errors?                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT_TR     I IS_REJECTED                   Has the Working Time Been Rejected?                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_CELL_CONTEXT_TR     I IS_RELEASED                   Was the Working Time Already Released?                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I CREATE_CELL                   Creates a Cell for Column                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I GET_COLUMN_TYPE               Column Type                                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I GET_SUB_COLUMNS               Get Subcolumns If Any Exist                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I IS_CUSTOMER_COLUMN            Is it a Customer Column?                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I IS_SUM_COLUMN                 Is it a Totals Column?                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO         I IS_TEXTFIELD                  Is it a Text Field?                                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I ADD_CLOCK_BEGIN_COLUMN        Add Column for Start Time                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I ADD_CLOCK_END_COLUMN          Add Column for End Time                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I ADD_SHORTTEXT_COLUMN          Add Column for Short Text                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I CREATE_SUM_CELL               Delivers Totals Cell for Target and Totals Row              .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I GET_CLOCK_BEGIN_COLUMN        Add Column for Start Time                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I GET_CLOCK_END_COLUMN          Add Column for Start Time                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I GET_DATE                      Delivers Date for Day Cell                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I SET_ACTUAL_WORKDATE           Set Information for Current Workday                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_COLUMN_INFO_DAY     I SET_TITLE                     Set Column Header Anew                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_DAY_INFO            I GET_PERIOD_INFO               Delivers Calendar Information for a Particular Period       .
IF_XSS_CAT_EMPLOYEE            I DEQUEUE_EMPLOYEE              Unlocks and Invalidates Employee                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_EMPLOYEE            I GET_COSTCENTER                Delivers Employee's Master Cost Center                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_EMPLOYEE            I GET_COSTCENTER_TEXT           Delivers Cost Center Text of Master Cost Center for a Date  .
IF_XSS_CAT_EMPLOYEE            I GET_NAME                      Delivers Employee's Formatted Name                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_EMPLOYEE            I GET_TARGET_HOURS              Delivers Employee's Target Hours                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_EMPLOYEE_MESSAGE          Adds Message with PERNR Reference to Message Handler        .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_INTERNAL_MESSAGE          Adds a General Message                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_PERIOD_MESSAGE            Adds a Period Message to Message Handler                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_RECORD_MESSAGE            Adds a Record Message to Message Handler                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I ADD_SIMULATION_MESSAGE        Adds a Simulation Message to Message Handler                .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_ALL_MESSAGES           Delete All Messages                                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_EMPLOYEE_MESSAGES      Deletes All Employee Messages According to Origin           .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESG_FOR_EMPLOYEE      Deletes All Employee Messages Accord. to Origin and Employee.
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESG_FOR_PERIOD        Deletes All Period Messages Accord. to Origin and Date      .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESG_FOR_RECORDS       Deletes All Record Messages Accord. to Origin and Record ID .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESSAGE                Deletes Message According to Message ID                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESSAGES               Deletes Several Messages Flagged by ID                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_MESSAGES_FOR_ORIGIN    Deletes All Messages from Originator                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_ONE_DISPLAY_MESSAGES   Deletes All Messages with DISPLAY_ONLY_ONE = 'X'            .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_PERIOD_MESSAGES        Deletes All Period Messages According to Origin             .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I DELETE_RECORD_MESSAGES        Deletes All Record Messages According to Origin             .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I GET_MAXIMUM_SEVERITY          Maximum Error Severity                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I GET_MESSAGE                   Delivers All Messages in Message Handler                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I GET_MESSAGES                  Delivers All Messages in Message Handler                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_MESSAGE_HANDLER     I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_RECORD       Delivers All Messages in Message Handler with Record Ref.   .
IF_XSS_CAT_RFC_COMMAND         I PROCESS_COMMAND               Processes FCode                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I FINISH_CREATE                 Completes Structure of a Row                                .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I FLUSH                         Transfer Changed Data to Backend                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I GET_CELL                      Get a Cell                                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I GET_CELL_TAB                  Delivers Cells in Row                                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I IS_MARKED                     Is the cell selected?                                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I REFRESH                       Preparation for Next Output                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW                 I SET_UI_ROW                    Sets Row to UI Values                                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I CREATE_FIELD_INFO             Get Object to Describe Column Info                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I CUMULATE_TIME_RECORDS         Delivers Total Number of Working Times                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I FILL_CPRO_CELLS               Gets Text Cells for cProject                                .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I FILL_TEXT_CELLS               Fill Text Cells in a Row                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_CLOCK_TIME_ROLLNAME       Delivers Data Element for Clock-Time Field                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_DAILY_SUMS                Get Daily Totals                                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_MESSAGES_FOR_RECORD       Get Messages for Record                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_QUAN_OR_AMOUNT_ROLLNAME   Delivers Data Element for Amount and Quantity Field         .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_SHORTTEXT_ROLLNAME        Delivers Data Element for Short Text                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I GET_TARGET_HOURS              Get Target Hours                                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I HAS_SUM_ROW                   Does the time sheet have a totals row?                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I HAS_TARGET_ROW                Does the time sheet have a target times row?                .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I IS_CELL_READ_ONLY_DEPENDENT   Cell read-only due to other account assignments?            .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I IS_EXCLUDED_FROM_TEMPLATE     Can row not be included in templates?                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_ROW_VERSIONSPECIFIC I PROFILE_COPY_HOURS            Check Profile Parameters                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I CALCULATE_SUM                 Calculates Total for a Quantity of Working Times            .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I CHECK_BEFORE_CONFIRMATION     Checks Time Sheet for All Known Personnel Numbers           .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I CHECK_FOR_RELEASE             Checks All Records for Release in the Buffer                .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I CHECK_TIME_SHEET              Checks Time Sheet for All Known Personnel Numbers           .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I CHECK_TIME_SHEET_FOR_PERIOD   Checks Time Sheet for Particular Period                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I DELETE_TIME_RECORDS           Set Records Specified by RECID to 0                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_CHANGED_RECORDS           Delivers All Records Changed During the Session             .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_CUSTOMER_TEXT_FOR_TS      DISPTEXT1 and DISPTEXT2 for One Row in the Time Sheet       .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_DEFAULT_UNIT_OF_HOUR      Checks Time Sheet for Particular Period                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_NEW_TIME_RECORD           Delivers a New Working Time Object with Only RECID + Pers.No.
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_RECORDS_FOR_RELEASE       Delivers Records Designated for Release                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_RECORDS_WITH_ERROR        Delivers a Table with RECIDs Whose Records Have Errors      .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I GET_TIME_RECORDS              Delivers Working Times for a Specific Period per Pers. No.  .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I HAS_ANYTHING_CHANGED          Does Data for Pers.No. Changed by User Exist in Buffer?     .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I HAS_RECORD_ERROR              Does the record have an 'E' or 'A' error? Yes = 'X'         .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I IS_TIME_RECORD_INITIAL        Can Record Be Displayed/Changed?                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I RELEASE_TIME_RECORDS          Release of Working Times for a Pers. No.                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I SAVE_TIME_SHEET               Saves Time Sheet for All Known Personnel Numbers            .
IF_XSS_CAT_TIME_SHEET          I SET_TIME_RECORDS              Changes Working Times per Pers. No.                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I GET_DATE                      Return Time                                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I GET_DATE_INTERVAL             Return Period                                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I GET_PERIOD_INFO               Delivers Calendar Information for a Particular Period       .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I GET_RECORD_MODE               Returns Current View (Day, Week View)                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I SELECT_CALENDAR_DATE          Set End Date for Calendar Selection                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_CALENDAR        I SELECT_DATE                   Set Time                                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I CHECK_AND_CONVERT             Check and Convert Value: From String to Value               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_CURRENCY_FIELD            Get Name of Currency Field                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_DATA_ELEMENT_INFO         Information About Data Element                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_QUANT_OR_AMOUNT_CONTEXT   Get Context for Quantity_or_Amount                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_REF_TO_DATA               Reference to Field of Current Type                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_TOOLTIP                   Delivers Tooltip                                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I GET_UNIT_FIELD                Get Name of Unit Field                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO      I IS_NOT_MODIFYABLE             Information on whether values from column are copied        .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_ACCOUNTING_FIELD          Sets Info for Account Assignment Fields                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_AMOUNT_FIELD              Sets Flag + Corresponding Currency Field                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_QUANTITY_FIELD            Sets Flag + Corresponding Unit Field                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_QUANT_OR_AMOUNT_CONTEXT   Sets Context for Conversion of Quantitiy/Amounts Fields     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_READ_ONLY_MODE            Sets Column to Read Only                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_TITLE                     Sets Modified Title                                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_TITLE_LONG                Sets Title with Max. 55 Characters                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_FIELD_INFO_INT  I SET_TOOLTIP                   Set a Tooltip                                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_MENUE           I GET_CURRENT_RECORD_MODE       Weekly or Daily Calendar                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_MENUE           I SET_NEW_RECORD_MODE           Weekly or Daily Calendar                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_MESSAGES        I ADD_RFC_MESSAGE               Add Message from RFC Layer                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_MESSAGES        I GET_MESSAGE                   Get Error Messages in UI Format                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_MESSAGES        I GET_MESSAGES                  Get Error Messages in UI Format                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_CELL_CONTEXT              Context for Each Cell                                       .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_FIELDLIST_DETAIL          Delivers Field List for Cell Detail                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_FIELD_LIST                Delivers Field List or Field Selection                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_HEADER                    Get Header (as Internal Table)                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_IS_RELEASE_DISABLED       If Release View Is Possible, Delivers ' ', Otherwise 'X'    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_RELEASE_STEP              Delivers Information Whether Release Step Required          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_TIME_SHEET                Get Time Sheet (as Internal Table)                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I GET_WORK_AREA_FOR_TIME_SHEET  Work Area                                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I HAS_SUM_ROW                   Does time sheet have a totals row?                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I HAS_TARGET_ROW                Does time sheet have a target hours row?                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I RELASE_TIME_RECORDS           Release List of Working Times                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TIME_SHEET      I SET_TIME_SHEET                Sets Time Sheet                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_ID                        Get ID for Working Time                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_INTERNAL_VALUE            Get Internal Display of Field                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_LONGTEXT                  Get Long Text                                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_QUANTITY_OR_AMOUNT        Sets Amount,...                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_STATISTIC_INFO            Statistical information                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_VALUE                     Get Value for Field Name                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I GET_WORKDATE                  Delivers Date for Working Time                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I HAS_DETAIL                    Does the Record Have Details?                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I HAS_ERRORS                    Error Status                                                .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I IS_ENTIRE_ROW_READ_ONLY       Is entire row read-only? (cPro + Scenario A)                .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I IS_MAINTAIN_VIA_GRID_POSSIBLE Can the Working Time Be Changed in the Grid?                .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I IS_READ_ONLY                  Can the Value Be Changed?                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I IS_REJECTED                   Rejected Record?                                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I IS_RELEASED                   Is the Record Released?                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I PREPARE_DELETE                Deletes Record                                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I SET_LONGTEXT                  Set Long Text                                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I SET_MARKER                    Sets Selection                                              .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I SET_QUANTITY_OR_AMOUNT        Sets Amount,...                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I SET_SORT_ID                   Sets Column Position                                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_ACCESS       I SET_VALUE                     Set Value of Working Time                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_DETAIL       I GET_DETAIL                    Returns Current Detail Record to Fields                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_DETAIL       I GET_FIELD_LIST                Delivers Field Selection for Detail                         .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_DETAIL       I GET_LONGTEXT                  Returns Long Text (Line Break = /n , / = //)                .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_DETAIL       I SET_DETAIL                    Sets Detail Fields                                          .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_DETAIL       I SET_LONGTEXT                  Sets Long Text ( /n = Line Break, // = /)                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I CHECK_TIME_SHEET              Business Layer Data Check                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I CREATE_NEW_TR                 Create a New Working Time                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I FLUSH_TO_BUSINESS_LAYER       Synchronize Data with Business Layer                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I GET_CHANGED_RECORDS           Get Modified Working Times                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I GET_MARKED_RECORDS            Get Selected Records                                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I GET_RECORDS_TO_BE_DELETED     Get Records with Delete Indicator                           .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I MARK_TIME_RECORDS_BY_IDS      Selects List of Working Times in the List                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I RELEASE_TIME_SHEET            Execute Release or Simulate                                 .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_TR_FACTORY      I RESET_CHANGED                 Reset Change Indicator (Records Have BL Status)             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WL_ACCESS       I GET_QUANTITY_OR_AMOUNT        Sets Amount,...                                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WL_ACCESS       I GET_VALUE                     Get Value for Field Name                                    .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I GET_CELL_CONTEXT              Delivers Context for Cells                                  .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I GET_FIELD_LIST                Delivers Field List or Field Selection                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I GET_SUM_COLUMN                Delivers Name of Total Column                               .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I GET_WORKLIST                  Get Worklist (as Internal Table)                            .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I GET_WORK_AREA_FOR_WORKLIST    Work Area                                                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_UIA_WORKLIST        I SET_WORKLIST                  Sets Worklist Selection                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I EXECUTE                       Delivers Hit List                                           .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I GET_HEADER                    Delivers Header Description of Hit List                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I GET_SELECTION_FIELDS_DEFAULTS Delivers Values for Selection Fields                        .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I GET_SLECTION_FIELDS           Delivers Selection Fields for Search Help                   .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Input Help                                      .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_HANDLER  I UPDATE_LINE_DATA              Sets Selected Values in the Row                             .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_MGR      I GET_VALUE_HELP                Returns Instance of a Search Help                           .
IF_XSS_CAT_VALUE_HELP_MGR      I INITIALIZE                    Initializes Search Help                                     .
IF_XSS_CAT_WORKLIST            I GET_CUSTOMER_TEXT_FOR_WL      DISPTEXT1 and DISPTEXT2 for a Cell in Worklist              .
IF_XSS_CAT_WORKLIST            I GET_WORKLIST_DETAILS          Delivers Worklist for Specified Period                      .
IF_XSS_PT_APPLICATION_CORE     I FINALIZE                      Termination                                                 .
IF_XSS_PT_APPLICATION_CORE     I HANDLE_MESSAGE                Process output                                              .
IF_XSS_PT_APPLICATION_CORE     I INITIALIZE                    Initialization of Backend                                   .
IF_XSS_PT_APPLICATION_CORE     I IS_ACTIVE                     Active?                                                     .
IF_XSS_PT_APPLICATION_CORE     I IS_VETO                       Veto triggered during message processing?                   .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I CALCULATE                     external system tax calculation                             .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I CHECK_ONLINE_UPDATE_SUPPORTED Check if online update is supported                         .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I DETERMINE_JURISDICTION        determine jurisdiction code                                 .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I FORCE                         force tax document to external tax system audit file        .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I SET_TTXD                      Set the TTXD structure with external system parameters      .
IF_XTAX_SYSTEM                 I UPDATE                        update tax document to external tax system audit file       .
IHC_CL_APPL_LOG                C ADD_MESSAGE                   Transfer Message to Application Log                         .
IHC_CL_APPL_LOG                C DISPLAY_LOG                   Output Application Log                                      .
IHC_CL_APPL_LOG                C GET_LOG_HANDLE                Read Current Log Handle                                     .
IHC_CL_APPL_LOG                C S_INSTANCE                    S_INSTANCE                                                  .
IHC_CL_DB                      C BREAK                         Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_DB                      C END                           Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_DB                      C END_LOG                       Read Messages and Close Log                                 .
IHC_CL_DB                      C START                         Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_DB                      C START_LOG                     Open Log and Write Messages                                 .
IHC_CL_DB_LIM                  C LOCK                          Request Lock                                                .
IHC_CL_DB_LIM                  C READ                          Request Lock                                                .
IHC_CL_DB_LIM                  C S_INSTANCE                    S_Instance_Methode                                          .
IHC_CL_DB_LIM                  C UNLOCK                        Request Lock                                                .
IHC_CL_DB_LIM                  C UPDATE                        Request Lock                                                .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C GET_CONTEXT_FIELDS            Read Context Information                                    .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C GET_CONTEXT_STRUCTURE         Determine Structure for Context                             .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C GET_FIELD                     Read Field Information                                      .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C GET_LAYER                     Read Layer Information                                      .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C GET_REFERENCE                 Read Reference Information                                  .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C S_INSTANCE                    Factory Method                                              .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C _GENERATE_CONTEXT             Generate Context Structure                                  .
IHC_CL_DB_LOG                  C _SET_CONTEXT_STATUS           Set the Status of a Context                                 .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C COMMIT                        Trigger Commit Work                                         .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C CREATE_CHANGE_DOCS            Create Change Documents                                     .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C GET_PN_SEMKEYS                Get Semantic Keys Based on Free Selection                   .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C GET_PN_SEMKEYS_EXTREF         Get Semantic Keys Based on Free Selection                   .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C INSERT                        Store New Payment Order on DB                               .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C LOCK                          Block Payment Order                                         .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C READ                          Execute Create or Update on the Database                    .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C READ_GUID                     Execute Create or Update on the Database                    .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C ROLLBACK                      Trigger Work Rollback                                       .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C SAVE_PN_ATTRS                 Payment Notes, Container Fields, Partner Address            .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C S_GET_KEYS                    S_Get_Keys Method                                           .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C S_INSTANCE                    S_Instance Method                                           .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C UNLOCK                        Unblock Payment Order                                       .
IHC_CL_DB_PN                   C UPDATE                        Change Payment Order on the Database                        .
IHC_CL_ENT                     C BREAK                         Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_ENT                     C END                           Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_ENT                     C END_LOG                       Read Messages and Close Log                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT                     C START                         Log Handling                                                .
IHC_CL_ENT                     C START_LOG                     Open Log and Write Messages                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C DELETE                        Delete Data from Database                                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C FIND                          Search Archive Files                                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C RELOAD                        Reload Archive Data (from File)                             .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C SELECT                        Select Orders for Archiving                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C WRITE                         Write Archive Data                                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _CREATE_INDEX                 Create Archive Index                                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _DELETE_FROM_TABLE            Delete Data from DB Table                                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _GET_CUSTOMIZING              Create Reference for Customizing Class                      .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _INSERT_INTO_TABLE            Write Data to the DB Table                                  .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _LOAD_ARCHIVE_VARIANTS        Load Archive Variants                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _READ_OBJECT                  Read Archive Object                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_ARCHIVE             C _UPDATE_INDEX                 Change Archive Index                                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C CHECH_IHC_ACTIVE              Checks if new IHC is active                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C CHECK_AUTHORITY               Authorization Check for Internal Action                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C CHECK_DUAL_CONTROL            Determine Dual Control Amount                               .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C FIND_BANK                     Find Bank Key Using Bank Country, No., SWIFT and Name       .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_BEST_MATCH_ENTRY          Search for Table with Best Match Method                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_CLEARING_PARTNERS         Delivers a list of all clearing partners in a bank area     .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_CLEARING_PARTNER_DETAILS  Get Details of Clearing Partner                             .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_CONTAINER_FIELDS          Search for Container Fields                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_DEFAULT_TRANSACTION       Determine Default for Transaction Type                      .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_IDOC_CLEARING_DATA        Get Communication Data for the Clearing Partner             .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_INSTRUCTIONS              Read Instructions for Instruction Key                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_MAPPED_PAY_METHOD         Maps the Payment Method and Payment Method Supplement       .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_POSTING_DATE              Return Posting Date                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_POST_BEHAVIOUR            Final, Provisional or No Posting in Postprocessing          .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_TRANSACTION_ATTR          Bank Transfer, Check, Debit Memo, Foreign, ...              .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_TRANSACTION_TYPE          Determine Transaction Type on the Basis of the Payment Order.
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_TRANSACTION_TYPES         Determine Transaction Types                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_UNIT_FROM_BANK_ID         Return Posting Date                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_UNIT_KEY                  Return Posting Date                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_XBS_CLEARING_DATA         Get Clearing Data for Bank Statement                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C GET_XBS_TRANSACTION_TYPE      Determine Transaction Type on the Basis of the Payment Order.
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C LOAD_CUSTOMIZED_MESSAGES      Read All Customizable Messages                              .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C LOAD_VARIANT                  Get Selection Variant                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C LOAD_WORKLIST                 Get Worklist                                                .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C ORGANIZE_VARIANTS             Manage Selection Variants                                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C ORGANIZE_WORKLISTS            Manage Worklists                                            .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C READ_CUSTOMIZED_MESSAGE       Determine Message Type for Customizable Messages            .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C READ_POST_BEHAVIOUR           Get Processing for Transaction Type                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C SAVE_VARIANT                  Save Selection Variants (Create/Change)                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C SAVE_WORKLIST                 Save Worklist (Create/Change)                               .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C S_INSTANCE                    Instance of a Multi-Instance Class                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C _CHECK_AUTHORITY              Authorization Check for GUI Action                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C _GET_DESCRIPTION              Determine Description of an Action                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C _ORGANIZE_VARIANTS            Manage Selection Variants                                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_CUST                C _SELECT_VARIANTS              Select Selection Variants                                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C COMMIT                        Trigger Commit Work                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C GET_LIMIT_EQ_AMNT             Get Equivalent Limit Amount                                 .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C LOAD_OBJECT                   Supply Object with Persistent Data                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C ROLLBACK                      Trigger Work Rollback                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C SET_SEMKEY                    Set Semantic Key                                            .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C SET_SINGLE_LIM_FIG            SET All Payment Order Data as Structure                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C S_INSTANCE                    Instance of a Multi-Instance Class                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_LIMIT               C S_STORE                       Place Object Data for MODIFY in Update Queue                .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C CHECK_NUMBERRANGE_4_SEMKEY    Set Up Semantic Key with Number Range                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C COMMIT                        Trigger Commit Work                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C COMPLETE_RINFO                Fill RINFO with Semantic Key                                .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C COMPLETE_STATUS               Fill STATI with Semantic Key                                .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C CREATE_GUID                   Provide GUID for Payment Order                              .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C DELETE_OBJECT                 Place Object Data for DELETE in Update Queue                .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_ALL                       Get All Payment Order Data as Structure                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_ARCHIVE_DATA              All Data for Payment Order for Archiving                    .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_CLEARING_PARTNER          Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_CLEARING_TYPE             Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_CL_PARTNER_LIST           List of Clearing Partners Found                             .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_LAST_STATUS               Shows the Previous Transition Between Two Statuses          .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_LAST_TRANSITION           Shows the Previous Transition Between Two Statuses          .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_OUTBOUND_IDOC_NUMBER      Get Outbound IDoc Number                                    .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_OUTBOUND_PRT_TYPE         Get Outbound IDoc Number                                    .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_BLOCK                  Returns a Status with Document References                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_ERROR                  Returns a Status with Document References                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_KEY_CDOC               Get All Payment Order Data as Structure                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_SEMKEY                 Returns a Semantic Key                                      .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_SEMKEYS                Get Semantic Keys Based on Free Selection                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_PN_SEMKEYS_EXTREF         Get Semantic Keys Based on Free Selection                   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_RCV_ACCT_AMNT_AND_CRCY    Set amount in currency of AMS account of clearing partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_RINFO                     Returns All Reference Information for a Payment Order       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_SEMKEY_FR_NUMBERRANGE     Set Up Semantic Key with Number Range                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_SND_ACCT_AMNT_AND_CRCY    Set amount in currency of AMS account of clearing partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_STATI                     Returns All PO Statuses                                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_STATUS                    Last Status and External Order, Block and Error Flag        .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C GET_TRNS_TYPE                 Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C LOAD_OBJECT                   Supply Object with Persistent Data                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C LOAD_RINFO                    Supply Reference Info with Persistent Data                  .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C LOAD_STATI                    Supply Statuses with Persistent Data                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C MAPP_TO_GUI_STATUS            Determine a PO GUI Status from a PO Status                  .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C ROLLBACK                      Trigger Work Rollback                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_ALL                       SET All Payment Order Data as Structure                     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_CLEARING_PARTNER          Set Clearing Partner                                        .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_CLR_BANK_DETAILS          Clearing Partner Bank Details                               .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_CL_PARTNER_LIST           List of Clearing Partners Found                             .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_NEW_REF                   Set Status Reference Documents                              .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_NEW_STATUS                Adds a Status with Reference Documents                      .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_PN_BLOCK                  Sets the Block Flag                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_PN_ERROR                  Sets the Block Flag                                         .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_RCV_ACCT_AMNT_AND_CRCY    Set amount in currency of AMS account of clearing partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_RINFO                     Inserts a Reference Inf. in the RINFO Tables of the PO      .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_SEMANTIC_KEY_ATTR         Sets the Semantic Key                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_SEMANTIC_KEY_DATA         Sets the Semantic Key                                       .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C SET_SND_ACCT_AMNT_AND_CRCY    Set amount in currency of AMS account of clearing partner   .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C STORE_OBJECT                  Place Object Data for MODIFY in Update Queue                .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_FLUSH_MEMORY                Delete Memory                                               .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_GET_KEYS                    Access to Semantic Key                                      .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_INSTANCE                    Instance of a Multi-Instance Class                          .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_INSTANCE_FOR_CHANGE         Singleton for Creating the Object Instances for Change      .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_INSTANCE_FOR_CREATION       Singleton for Creating the Object Instances for Storing     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_INSTANCE_FOR_DISPLAY        Singleton for Creating the Object Instances for Display     .
IHC_CL_ENT_PN                  C S_INSTANCE_FOR_TEST           Singleton for Creating the Object Instances for Display     .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C BREAK                         For Status-Independent Actions                              .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C BREAK_ACTION                  Close Log, Set Rollback and Error Flag                      .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C END                           For Status-Independent Actions                              .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C END_LOG                       Read Messages and Close Log                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C END_OF_ACTION                 Inserts correct status at end of action and closes log      .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C GET_AUTHORITY_FLAG            Read Authorization Error Indicator                          .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C GET_INSTANCE                  Get Instance of a Payment Order                             .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C SET_AUTHORITY_FLAG            Set Authorization Error Indicator                           .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C START                         For Status-Independent Actions                              .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C START_LOG                     Open Log and Write Messages                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC                    C START_OF_ACTION               Check if an action may be executed, open log                .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C COMMIT                        Trigger the Commit                                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_ITEMS                  Generation of Payment Items for the Acct Management System  .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_RECEIVERITEM           Generation of Recipient Items for the Acct Management System.
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_REFERENCE_FOR_AMS      Generation of Reference for the Account Management System   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_SENDERITEM             Generation of Sender Items for the Acct Management System   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_SPREADITEM             Generation of Currency Conversion Items                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CREATE_SPREAD_AMOUNT          Generation of Currency Conversion Revenue Amount            .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CUST_GET_CLRG_PRT_BANK_DET    Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CUST_GET_FX_RATE              Read Secondary Settlement Rate                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CUST_GET_POSTING_PARAMS       Read Posting Parameters for the Account Management System   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CUST_GET_PRELIMINARY_ACCT     Generation of Reference for the Account Management System   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C CUST_GET_SPR_ACCT_FOR_AMS     Determination of the Currency Conversion Revenue Account    .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C DO_CONVERSION                 Foreign Currency Conversion                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_ACCT_CURR_FROM_AMS        Determination of Acct Currency from Acct Management System  .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_ACCT_HOLDER_NUMBER        Get Account Holder Number                                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_CLEARING_TYPE             Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_CLRG_ACCT_FOR_AMS         Determination of NOSTRO/LORO Account for Clearing Partner   .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_RCV_ACCT_FOR_AMS          Determination of Recipient Account for Acct Man. System     .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_SND_ACCT_FOR_AMS          Determination of Sender Acct for Account Management System  .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_TRANSACTION_DATES         Determination of Relevant Date Details                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_TRANSACTION_TYPE          Determination of the Transaction Type for the Acct Man. Sys..
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C GET_TRANSACTION_VALUES        Determination of Amounts                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C MODIFY_ITEMS_BY_BADI          Generation of Payment Items for the Acct Management System  .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C PN_AMS_POST                   Posting of a Payment Order in the Account Management System .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C PN_AMS_PREPOST                Posting of a Payment Order in the Account Management System .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C PN_AMS_REWIND                 Offsetting Posting of a Payment Order in Account Man. System.
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C REVERSE_PAYMITEM_FROM_STATUS  Reverse Posted Items in Account Management System           .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C ROLLBACK                      Formal Check, Determination of Recipient Data and Log Check .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C SET_LIMIT_FIGURES             Save Limit Data for Limit Update Later                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C SET_PN_REF                    Add a Reference to a Payment Order                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C STORE_LIMIT_FIGURES           Save Limit Data for Limit Update Later                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C S_INSTANCE                    Instance of a Singleton Instance Class                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C TRANSFER_ITEM_TO_AMS          Transfer Payment Items to the Account Management System     .
IHC_CL_PROC_CL                 C TRANSFER_NOTES_FOR_AMS        Generation of Text Information for Account Management System.
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC               C FILL_ERROR                    Fill Error Status and Return Variables                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC               C FILL_RETURN_VARIABLES         Fill Return Variable                                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC               C FILL_STATUS                   Fill Status                                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC               C GET_SEGM_SECTION              Get IDoc Segments and Subsegments                           .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC               C _READ_SUB_SEGMENTS            Internal: Get Subsegments                                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C CHECK_CONDITIONS              Acceptance of an IDoc Under Certain Conditions              .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C CREATE_NOTES                  Create a Payment Notes Line from a Line Item                .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C CREATE_PN_FROM_IDOC           Creates a Payment Order from an IDoc                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDK02                       (1,1,0) Document Header Reference Data                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDK03                       (1,3,0) Document Header Date Segment                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDK12                       (1,99,0) Document Header Reference Data                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDK14                       (1,10,0) Document Header Organization Data                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDKA1                       (1,4,0) Document Header Partner Information                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDP02                       (1,4,0) Document Item Reference Data                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1EDP03                       (1,4,0) Document Item Date Segment                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDB02                       (1,4,0) Extended Bank Details (FII/CTA/COM)                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDBL2                       (1,10,0) Correspondence Banks                               .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDBW1                       (1,4,1) Special Instructions (INP)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDKU1                       (1,1,1) Header Transfer Order/Payment Advice Note (BGM)     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDKU2                       (1,1,0) Function of Trading Transaction (BUS)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDKU3                       (1,1,0) Payment Instructions (PAI)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDKU4                       (1,1,0) Payment Instructions (PAI)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDKU5                       (1,1,1) Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDLU5                       (1,10,1) Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDPU1                       (1,200000,0) ITEM (DOC)                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDPU5                       (1,10,0) AMOUNTS (MOA/CUX)  Child of PU1                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDT01                       (1,1,0) Long Texts                                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C E1IDT02                       (1,100,0) Long Texts                                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C MAPP_PN                       PO Mapping from Segments                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PN          C TRANSFER_IDOC_2_PN            Transfers and IDoc to a Payment Order                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CHECK_IDOC                    Check if IDoc is Correct                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_POSITIONS              Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Generation         .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_PRQ_DATA               Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Generation         .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_PRQ_FR_IDOC_STRUCT     Generation of Payment Requests from IDocs                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_SIGNS                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Generation         .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_SINGLE_PRQ             Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Generation         .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CREATE_SPLIT_PRQS             Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Generation         .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CUST_CLEARING_PARTNER         Customizing: Derive Payment Order Attributes                .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CUST_PAYM_PARAMETERS          Customizing: Derive Payment Order Attributes                .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C CUST_POSTING_ACCTS            Customizing: Derive Payment Order Attributes                .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDK02                       (1,1,0) Document Header Reference Data                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDK03                       (1,3,0) Document Header Date Segment                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDK12                       (1,99,0) Document Header Reference Data                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDK14                       (1,10,0) Document Header Organization Data                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDKA1                       (1,4,0) Document Header Partner Information                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDP02                       (1,4,0) Document Item Reference Data                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1EDP03                       (1,4,0) Document Item Date Segment                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDB02                       (1,4,0) Extended Bank Details (FII/CTA/COM)                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDBL2                       (1,10,0) Correspondence Banks                               .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDBW1                       (1,4,1) Special Instructions (INP)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDKU1                       (1,1,1) Header Transfer Order/Payment Advice Note (BGM)     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDKU2                       (1,1,0) Function of Trading Transaction (BUS)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDKU3                       (1,1,0) Payment Instructions (PAI)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDKU5                       (1,1,1) Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDLU5                       (1,10,1)  Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDPU1                       (1,200000,0) ITEM (DOC)                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDPU5                       (1,10,1) AMOUNTS (MOA/CUX)  Child of PU1                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDT01                       (1,1,0) Long Texts                                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C E1IDT02                       (1,100,0) Long Texts                                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_ADDRESS                  Fill the Participating Addresses                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_AMOUNTS                  Fill the Amounts                                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_BANKS                    Fill the Bank Details                                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_CBANREP                  Fill the Central Bank Reporting                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_CORR_DOC                 Fill the Reference Information                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_DATES                    Fill the Date Details                                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_INSTRUCTIONS             Fill the Instructions                                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_ORG_AND_ACCTS            Fill the Participating Accounts                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_ORIGIN                   Fill the Source                                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_PAYM_CNTRL               Fill the Payment Instructions (Individual, Rapid ...)       .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_REFINFO                  Transfer Reference Information as Free Text                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_SINGLE_ADDRESS           Fill the Participating Addresses                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_SINGLE_AMOUNT            Fill the Amounts                                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_SINGLE_CBANREP           Fill the Central Bank Reporting                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C FILL_SINGLE_REFINFO           Transfer Reference Information as Free Text                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C SET_ALL_POS_AS_TXT            Creates a Payment Order from an IDoc                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C SET_PAYRQ_REFTXT              Creates a Payment Order from an IDoc                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C SET_SINGLE_POS_AS_TXT         Creates a Payment Order from an IDoc                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C S_INSTANCE                    Instance of a Singleton Instance Class                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ         C TRANSFER_PRQ_TO_PS            Generates a Payment Order from an IDoc                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C ARCHIVE_DELETE                Archive Payment Order (Delete DB)                           .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C ARCHIVE_LOAD                  Reload Payment Orders (Write DB)                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C ARCHIVE_WRITE                 Archive Payment Orders (Write Archive)                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C BLOCK                         Process Several Payment Orders from GUI                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CANC                          Reverse Several Payment Orders                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CANCEL                        Reverse or Delete Several Payment Orders                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CHECK_PN_CHANNEL              Channel-Dependent Checks                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CHECK_PN_CHANNEL_MASS         Channel-Dependent Checks, Mass Processing                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CLEAR_ERROR                   Delete Error                                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C CREATE                        Generate a Payment Order                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DELETE                        Delete Several Payment Orders                               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DETERMINE                     Process Several Payment Orders                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DET_HEADER                    Formal Check, Determination of Recipient Data and Log Check .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DISPATCH                      Process Until Route Determination (Inclusive)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DISPATCH_POST                 Process Until Route Determination (Inclusive)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DISPLAY_CHANGE_DOCUMENT       Return Clearing Partners Found                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DISPLAY_SINGLE_PN             Return Clearing Partners Found                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C DUAL_TO_PROCESSED             Transfer from Suspend to Posting                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C EXT_ORDER_POST                Generate a PAYEXT-IDOC from a Payment Order                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C FINAL_POST                    Post Finally                                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_CLR_PRTN_DTLS             Gets the Clearing Partner Details for Prima Nota            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_CL_PARTNER_LIST           Return Clearing Partners Found                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_PN_SEMKEYS                Free Selection of Payment Orders                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_PN_SEMKEY_EXTREF          Free Selection of Payment Orders                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_REFERENCE                 Return Payment Notes for a Payment Order                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C GET_STATUS_HISTORY            Return Status History of a Payment Order                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C POST                          Suspend Without Posting                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C PREPROCESS                    Process Until Route Determination (Inclusive)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C PROCESS                       Process Several Payment Orders from GUI                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C PROCESSED_TO_DUAL             Prepare for Dual Control                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C PROCESSED_TO_STOP             Suspend Without Posting                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C PROCESS_IN_BG                 Send Payment Orders to Background                           .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C READ                          Read Several Payment Orders                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C READ_CHANGE_DOCS              Read Change Documents                                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C READ_FOR_CHANGE               Read and Block Several Payment Orders                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C READ_PN_FROM_CM               Return Provisional Turnover                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C RELEASE                       Release Several Payment Orders                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C REPROCESS                     Revaluate Payment Orders                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C RESET                         Reset Several Payment Orders to Create Mode                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C ROLLBACK                      Rollback                                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C SAVE                          Save Multiple Payment Orders                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C STOP_TO_PROCESSED             Transfer from Suspend to Posting                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C UNBLOCK                       Process Several Payment Orders from GUI                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C UPDATE_ENTITY                 Update Entire PO in GUI PO Entity                           .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C UPDATE_EXTERNAL_DOCUMENTS     Read Cross-System References and Write to PO                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C _CHECK_PN_CHANNEL_DIRECT      Channel-Dependent Checks for Direct PO Receipt              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C _CHECK_PN_CHANNEL_IDOC        Channel-Dependent Checks for Payment Orders from IDoc       .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C _CHECK_PN_CHANNEL_MANUAL      Channel-Dependent Checks for Manual Payment Orders          .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C _CHECK_PN_CHANNEL_XBS         Channel-Dependent Checks for External Bank Statements       .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN                 C _CHECK_PN_GENERAL             Channel-Dependent Checks                                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C COMPLETE_IDOC                 Completes the Generated IDoc                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C CREATE_IDOC_FROM_IDOC         Creates an IDoc from the Inbound IDoc of a Payment Order    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C CREATE_IDOC_FROM_PN           Creates and IDoc from a Payment Order                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDK02                       (1,1,0) Document Header Reference Data                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDK03                       (1,3,0) Document Header Date Segment                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDK12                       (1,99,0) Document Header Reference Data                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDK14                       (1,10,0) Document Header Organization Data                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDKA1                       (1,4,0) Document Header Partner Information                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDP02                       (1,4,0) Document Item Reference Data                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1EDP03                       (1,4,0) Document Item Date Segment                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDB02                       (1,4,0) Extended Bank Details (FII/CTA/COM)                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDBL2                       (1,10,0) Correspondence Banks                               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDBW1                       (1,4,1) Special Instructions (INP)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDKU1                       (1,1,1) Header Transfer Order/Payment Advice Note (BGM)     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDKU2                       (1,1,0) Function of Trading Transaction (BUS)               .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDKU3                       (1,1,0) Payment Instructions (PAI)                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDKU5                       (1,1,1) Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                   .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDLU5                       (1,10,1) Amounts on Header Level (MOA/CUX)                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDPU1                       (1,200000,0) ITEM (DOC)                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDPU5                       (1,10,0) AMOUNTS (MOA/CUX)  Child of PU1                    .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDT01                       (1,1,0) Long Texts                                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C E1IDT02                       (1,100,0) Long Texts                                        .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C FILL_SEG_LINKS                Link the IDoc Segments                                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C INSERT_SEG                    Inserts a Segment on Level 1                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C MAPP_IDOC                     Segment Mapping from the PO                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_2_IDOC          C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_EXTERNAL_DOCUMENTS        Read Several Payment Orders                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_EXTERNAL_PAYRQ            Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_EXTERNAL_PN               Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_OUTB_IDOC_INFORMATION     Get_outbound_communication_information                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_REMOTE_IDOC_INFORMATION   Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C GET_RFC_DEST                  Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C READ_PN_VIA_IDOCNUMBER        Read Payment Orders via Generating IDoc Number              .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C REVERSE_EXTERNAL_DOCUMENTS    Read Several Payment Orders                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C REVERSE_EXTERNAL_PAYRQ        Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C REVERSE_EXTERNAL_PN           Query of FI Payment Orders Created Remotely                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_PN_XDOCS           C _GET_EXTERNAL_DOCUMENTS       Read Several Payment Orders                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C COMMIT                        Trigger the Commit                                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C CREATE_NODES_ID               Assigns a Unique ID per Node                                .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C CREATE_RT_TREE                Reads from Database to Routing Tree                         .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C DETERMINE_ROUTING             New Solution: Runs Checks and Returns a Route               .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C FILL_INSTR_TAB                Fills the Static Instruction Table                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_CRITERIAS         Generation of Attribute Checks                              .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_DATA_DEFINITION   Generation of Definition Segment                            .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_RANGES_CHECKS     Generation of Range Checks                                  .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_RANGES_DEF        Generation of Range Definitions                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_RANGES_FILL_FORMS Generation of Forms for Filling Range                       .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_ROUTING           Generation of Routing Check                                 .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C GENERATE_RT_SELOPT            Fill Ranges with Selection Options                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C OUT_ROUTING_TREE              Output of Routing Tree                                      .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C REC_PARTNER_LIST              Determine Route                                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C REC_ROUTE_DET                 Determine Route                                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_ROUTING            C WRITE_INSTR                   Creates an Instruction and Inserts it in the Forms Table    .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C CHECK_CHARGES                 Check if the item is a charge item                          .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C DETERMINE_RECEIVER            Creates a Payment Order from an External Bank Statement     .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C GET_CHARGE_AMOUNT             Calculate Total Charges                                     .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C GET_NEIGHBOURS                Adjacent Object of Charge Items                             .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C S_INSTANCE                    Instantiate an Object (Singleton, Multi-Instanz)            .
IHC_CL_PROC_XBS                C TRANSFER_XBS_TO_PN            Creates a Payment Order from an External Bank Statement     .
IHC_CL_UTIL_AMS_FACTORY        C S_GET_AMS_INTERFACE           Gets Reference for Posting System Interface                 .
IHC_CL_UTIL_BCA                C INITIALIZE                    Initialize BCA Systems                                      .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C ADD_MESSAGE                   Write Messages to Log                                       .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C CLOSE_LOG                     Closes (and Possibly Saves) a Log                           .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C DISABLE_LOG                   Switch Off Logging                                          .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C DISPLAY_LOG                   Display Messages in Log                                     .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C FIND_LOG                      Search for Log                                              .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C GET_LOG_FOR_ARCHIVE           Get Log Data for Archiving                                  .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C OPEN_LOG                      Open (New or Old) Log                                       .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C S_INSTANCE                    Factory Method                                              .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _CREATE_EXTERNAL_NUMBER       Generate External Number                                    .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _GET_DB_REFERENCE             Factory Method for DB Instance                              .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _OPEN_LOG                     Open Log                                                    .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _SAVE_CONTEXT                 Transfer Context to Log                                     .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _SAVE_LOG                     Saves a Log                                                 .
IHC_CL_UTIL_LOG                C _SET_CONTEXT                  Fill Current Context                                        .
IHC_CL_UTIL_WORKFLOW           C DISPLAY                       Display Payment Order                                       .
IHC_CL_UTIL_WORKFLOW           C EDIT                          Edit Payment Order                                          .
IHC_CL_UTIL_WORKFLOW           C EXISTENCECHECK                Check Existence                                             .
IHC_CL_UTIL_WORKFLOW           C RAISE_EVENT                   Trigger IHC Workflow Event                                  .
IHC_CL_UTIL_WORKFLOW           C _RAISE_EVENT                  Trigger IHC Workflow Event                                  .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I CHECK_IF_UNIT_EXISTS          Check if Posting System Unit Exists                         .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I DISPLAY_ACCOUNT               Display Account                                             .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I DISPLAY_PAYMENT_ORDER         Display Payment Item                                        .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I F4_ACCOUNTS                   F4 Help for Posting System Accounts                         .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I F4_UNITS                      F4 Help for Posting System Units                            .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_ACCOUNTS_FOR_BP           Determine All Accounts of a Business Partner                .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_ACCOUNT_DATA              Determine Data for Account                                  .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_ACCOUNT_HOLDER            Determine Account Holder                                    .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_POSTING_DATE              Get Current Posting Date                                    .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_UNIT                      Determine Posting System Unit                               .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I GET_UNIT_DATA                 Determine Data for Posting System Unit                      .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I POST_PAYMENT_ITEM             Post Payment Items in Posting System                        .
IHC_IF_UTIL_AMS_FUNCTIONS      I POST_PAYMENT_ORDER            Post Payment Order in Posting System                        .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CHECK_IDOC                    Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_POSITIONS              Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_PRQ_DATA               Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_PRQ_FR_IDOC_STRUCT      Creation of Payment Requests from IDOCs                    .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_SIGNS                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_SINGLE_PRQ             Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CREATE_SPLIT_PRQS             Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CUST_CLEARING_PARTNER         Customizing: Derivation of Attributes for Payment Requests  .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CUST_PAYM_PARAMETERS          Customizing: Derivation of Attributes for Payment Requests  .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C CUST_POSTING_ACCTS            Customizing: Derivation of Attributes for Payment Requests  .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDK02                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDK03                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDK12                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDK14                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDKA1                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDP02                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1EDP03                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDB02                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDBL2                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDBW1                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDKU1                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDKU2                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDKU3                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDKU5                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDLU5                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDPU1                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDPU5                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDT01                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C E1IDT02                       Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_ADDRESS                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_AMOUNTS                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_BANKS                    Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_CBANREP                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_CORR_DOC                 Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_DATES                    Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_INSTRUCTIONS             Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_ORG_AND_ACCTS            Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_ORIGIN                   Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_PAYM_CNTRL               Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_REFINFO                  Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_SINGLE_AMOUNT            Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_SINGLE_CBANREP           Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_SINGLE_REFINFO           Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C FILL_STATUS                   Fill Status                                                 .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C GET_SEGM_SECTION              Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C SET_ALL_POS_AS_TXT            Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C SET_SINGLE_POS_AS_TXT         Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C S_INSTANCE                     Instance of Singleton Instance Class                       .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C TRANSFER_PRQ_TO_PS            Fill BAPI Structures for Payment Request Creation           .
IHC_PI_CL_PROC_IDOC_2_PRQ      C _READ_SUB_SEGMENTS            Internal: Get Subsegments                                   .
INT_FQST_CIN_SURCHARGE         I CALC_INH_BASE_CEINV           Inherit Base Enabled for Central invoice prop.              .
INT_FQST_CIN_SURCHARGE         I CALC_INH_BASE_CEINV_PP        Inherit Base Enabled for Ceinv prop for partial payment.    .
ISAUTO_XLO_CL_UTIL             C BAL_LOG_CREATE                Structure and Creation of Application Log from BAPIRET2_T   .
ISAUTO_XLO_CL_UTIL             C MESSAGE_COLLECT               Format and Source of a Message in BAPIRET2_T                .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C KNA1_GET                      Get KNA1 from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C KNB1_GET                      Get KNB1 from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C KNB5_GET                      Get KNB5 from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C KNVI_GET                      Get KNVI from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C KNVV_GET                      Get KNB1 from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C LFA1_GET                      Get LFA1 from CVI                                           .
ISM_CVI_ADAPTER                C LFB1_GET                      Get LFB1 from CVI                                           .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C GET_USAGE                     Sets the Caller (IKS, Export Services, and so on)           .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C LOG_WRITE_MSG1                Write to Log: 1 Parameter                                   .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C LOG_WRITE_MSG2                Write to Log: 2 Parameters                                  .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C LOG_WRITE_MSG3                Write to Log: 3 Parameters                                  .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C LOG_WRITE_MSG4                Write to Log: 4 Parameters                                  .
IWB_XML_CONV_PARAMETER         C SET_USAGE                     Fetches the Caller (IKS, Export Services, and so on)        .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I CHECK_REGISTERED_DOC_TYPES    Checks Whether the Required Applications Exist              .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I DESTROY_CONTROL               Destroys Control                                            .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_CONTROL_HANDLE            Obsolete: Use GET_CONTROL_OBJECT Instead                    .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_CONTROL_OBJECT            Returns a Reference to the Control Object                   .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_DOCUMENT_PROXY            Creates an Instance for Document Management                 .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_EXTENSIONS                Get Extensions for ProgID from Registry                     .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_LINK_SERVER               Creates an Instance for the Link Server                     .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_REGISTERED_DOC_TYPES      Returns a List of All Existing Applications                 .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I GET_TABLE_COLLECTION          Returns an Instance for Managing the Table Collection       .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I INIT_CONTROL                  Creates and Initializes the Control                         .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I LINK_CONTROL                  Obsolete: Link Using Container Objects                      .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I RELEASE_ALL_DOCUMENTS         Releases all Frontend Resources for All Documents           .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I SET_FOCUS                     Sets Focus to the Control                                   .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I SET_INPLACE_BORDER_SPACE      Obsolete                                                    .
I_OI_CONTAINER_CONTROL         I SET_WINDOW_PROPERTIES         Obsolete: Use Container Methods Instead                     .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I ADD_MENU_BAR                  Creates an Extra Menu Bar in the Office Application         .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I ADD_MENU_ITEM                 Inserts a New Menu Entry in a Menu                          .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I ADD_MENU_POPUP                Insets a New Menu in a Menu Bar                             .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I CLEAR_SELECTION               Clears Selection                                            .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I CLOSE_ACTIVEX_DOCUMENT        Closes a Visual Basic Document                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I CLOSE_DOCUMENT                Closes a Document in the Office Application                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I COPY_SELECTION                Copies a Selected Area to the Clipboard                     .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I CREATE_DOCUMENT               Opens a New Document in the Office Application              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I CUT_SELECTION                 Cuts the Selected Area From the Office Application          .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I DELETE_MENU_ITEM              Menu Entry Deleted in the Office Application                .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I EXECUTE_MACRO                 Executes a Macro in the Office Application                  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_APPLICATION_PROPERTY      Gets the Attributes of a Desktop Application                .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_DOCUMENT_COOKIE           Returns a Document ID                                       .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_DOCUMENT_HANDLE           Gets the Automation Handle of the Document                  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_DOCUMENT_TYPE             Gets the Relevant Document Type                             .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_FORM_INTERFACE            Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_MAIL_MERGE_INTERFACE      Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_PIVOT_INTERFACE           Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_SCRIPT_COLLECTION         Returns a Reference to a Script Collection                  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_SPREADSHEET_INTERFACE     Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_TEMPLATE_INTERFACE        Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I GET_WORDPROCESSOR_INTERFACE   Returns an Interface Reference                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_CHANGED                   Indicates Whether The Document Changed in the Office Appl.  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_FORM_INTERFACE            Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_MAIL_MERGE_INTERFACE      Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_PIVOT_INTERFACE           Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_SPREADSHEET_INTERFACE     Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_STANDARD_INTERFACE        Indicates Whether There is a Standard Interface for Doc Type.
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_TEMPLATE_INTERFACE        Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I HAS_WORDPROCESSOR_INTERFACE   Indicates Whether Interface Is Supported For This Doc. Type .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I IS_DESTROYED                  Indicates Whether all Resources Have Already Been Released  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I IS_OPEN                       Indicates Whether a Document is Already Open                .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I OPEN_ACTIVEX_DOCUMENT         Opens a Visual Basic Document                               .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I OPEN_DOCUMENT                 Opens an Existing Document                                  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I OPEN_DOCUMENT_FROM_TABLE      Opens an Existing Document                                  .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PAGE_SETUP                    Starts the Page Setup Dialog                                .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PASTE_CLIPBOARD               Inserts the Contents of the Clipboard in Document (Fixed)   .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PASTE_SPECIAL                 Inserts the Contents of the Clipboard in the Document (Link).
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PLAY_DOCUMENT                 Plays Document                                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PLAY_DOCUMENT_FROM_TABLE      Plays Document                                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I PRINT_DOCUMENT                Prints an Open Document in the Office Application           .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I RELEASE_DOCUMENT              Releases the Memory Used by the Document                    .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I REOPEN_DOCUMENT               Reopens a Buffered Document                                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SAVE_AS                       Saves Document Locally on Frontend                          .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SAVE_COPY_AS                  Saves Document Locally on Frontend                          .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SAVE_DOCUMENT_TO_TABLE        Saves an Office Document in an Internal Table               .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SAVE_DOCUMENT_TO_URL          Saves an Office Document Under a URL                        .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SELECT_ALL                    Selects Entire Office Document                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I SET_BASE_URL                  Sets Base URL for Template Designer                         .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I UPDATE_DOCUMENT_LINKS         Forces Link update After Opening                            .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I VIEW_DOCUMENT                 Display Presentation Data Saved in Document                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_PROXY            I VIEW_DOCUMENT_FROM_TABLE      Display Presentation Data Saved in Document                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_VIEWER           I CLOSE_DOCUMENT                Close the Document                                          .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_VIEWER           I DESTROY_VIEWER                Destroy the Viewer Instance                                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_VIEWER           I INIT_VIEWER                   Initialize the Viewer Instance                              .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_VIEWER           I VIEW_DOCUMENT_FROM_TABLE      Display the Document from an Internal Table                 .
I_OI_DOCUMENT_VIEWER           I VIEW_DOCUMENT_FROM_URL        Display the Document Using a URL                            .
I_OI_ERROR                     I FLUSH_ERROR                   For Internal Use                                            .
I_OI_ERROR                     I GET_MESSAGE                   Returns Error Data                                          .
I_OI_ERROR                     I RAISE_MESSAGE                 Triggers Error Display for Error                            .
I_OI_FORM                      I ADD_FIELD                     Adds a Field in the Document                                .
I_OI_FORM                      I DELETE_FIELDS                 Deletes Fields in the Document                              .
I_OI_FORM                      I DISCONNECT_FIELDS             Disconnects Fields from ABAP                                .
I_OI_FORM                      I GET_DATA                      Gets Data from Application                                  .
I_OI_FORM                      I GET_FORM_FIELDS               Gets Field Names                                            .
I_OI_FORM                      I LOAD_LIB                      Load DLL                                                    .
I_OI_FORM                      I PROTECT                       Switches Between Protected and Unprotected                  .
I_OI_FORM                      I SET_DATA                      Sets the Data in the Application                            .
I_OI_FORM                      I SET_MODUS                     Switches Between Designe and View Mode                      .
I_OI_FORM                      I SYNCHRONIZE_FIELDS            Synchronizes the Document Properties and the Fields         .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I ADD_BINARY_ITEM               Add a Binary Object (Graphic..) to the Link Server          .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I ADD_STRING_ITEM               Add a Data Field to the Link Server                         .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I ADD_TABLE_ITEM                Add an Internal Table to the Link Server (Obsolete)         .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I ADD_TABLE_ITEM2               Add an Internal Table to the Link Server                    .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I COPY_LINK_ITEM_TO_CLIPBOARD   Places a Link to a Link Item on the Clipboard               .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I EXECUTE_COPY_LINK_DIALOG      Dialog for Selecting a Link Item                            .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I REMOVE_LINK_ITEM              Deletes a Link Server Entry                                 .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I START_LINK_SERVER             Initializes and/or Activates the Link Server                .
I_OI_LINK_SERVER               I STOP_LINK_SERVER              Deactivates the Link Server                                 .
I_OI_MAIL_MERGE                I VIEW_FIELD_CODES              Show Field Codes                                            .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I ADD_NEW_DATA                  Insert New Data                                             .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I DRILL_DOWN                    Drilldown in Pivot Table                                    .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I DRILL_UP                      Close a View                                                .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I GET_ALLFIELDS                 Get all Entries                                             .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I GET_ALLPIVOTTABLES            Get Names of All Pivot Tables                               .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I INSERT_FULL                   Insert a Pivot Table                                        .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I SET_FIELDTYPE                 Set Type of an Entry                                        .
I_OI_PIVOT                     I SET_SOURCE_TABLE              Set Data                                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I ADD_SHEET                     Inserts a Worksheet                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I ADD_STYLE                     Add Styles                                                  .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CELL_FORMAT                   Sets Individual Cell Attributes                             .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CHANGE_RANGE                  Change Size or Name of an Area                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CHANGE_STYLE                  Change Styles                                               .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CLEAR_ALL_RANGES              Deletes the Contents and Formatting of the Ranges           .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CLEAR_CONTENT_RANGE           Delete Content of a Range                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CLEAR_HIERARCHY               Delete Hierarchy                                            .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I CLEAR_RANGE                   Delete Content and Formatting of a Range                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I DELETE_CONTENT_RANGES         Deletes Ranges                                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I DELETE_RANGES                 Deletes Entire Ranges                                       .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I DELETE_SHEET                  Deletes a Worksheet                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I FIT_WIDEST                    Adapt to Widest Column                                      .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_ACTIVE_SHEET              Get Active Worsheet                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_CELL_FORMAT               Get Format of a Line                                        .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_CELL_FORMATS_TABLE        Gets Information about Cells                                .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_DIMENSION                 Get Dimensions of a Range                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_DIMENSION_TABLE           Returns a Table Containing Ranges                           .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_PROTECTION                Get Protected Attribute of a Worksheet                      .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_RANGES_DATA               Get Name and Data for Range                                 .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_RANGES_NAMES              Get Name of a Range                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_SELECTED_AREAS            Returns a Collection of Selected Ranges                     .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_SELECTION                 Get a Selection                                             .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_SHEETS                    Get the Names of Worksheets                                 .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_STYLE                     Read Style of an Area                                       .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I GET_STYLE_FORMATS             Read All Style Names                                        .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I HIDE_COLUMNS                  Hide Columns                                                .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I HIDE_ROWS                     Hide Rows                                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I INSERT_FULL                   Inserst Values                                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I INSERT_ONE_TABLE              Insert a Table                                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I INSERT_RANGE                  Insert a New Range                                          .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I INSERT_RANGES                 Inserts Several Ranges                                      .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I INSERT_RANGE_DIM              Get a Range Based on its Dimensions                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I LOAD_LIB                      Load DLL                                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I PRINT                         Print a Worksheet                                           .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I PROTECT                       Protect the Active Sheet                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I PROTECT_RANGE                 Sets the Protected Attribute for a Range                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SCREEN_UPDATE                 Controls the Screen Update                                  .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SELECT_RANGE                  Select a Range                                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SELECT_SHEET                  Activate a Sheet                                            .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SETLOCALE                     Sets the Date and Decimal Format                            .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_COLOR                     Set the Color of a Range                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_DATA_TABLE                Sets the Data Table                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FIXED_COLS                Sets the Number of Fixed Columns                            .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FIXED_ROWS                Sets the Number of Fixed Rows                               .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FONT                      Set the Font for a Range                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FORMAT                    Set the Format of a Range                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FORMAT_STRING             Set the Format of a Range                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_FRAME                     Set a Frame for a Range                                     .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_HEADER                    Sets a Header                                               .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_HIERARCHY                 Sets Hierarchy                                              .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_HIERARCHY_TABLE           Sets the Hierarchies Using a Table                          .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_INFO_TABLE                Sets the Info Table                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_RANGES_DATA               Set the Data for a Range                                    .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_RANGES_FORMAT             Set the Format of a Range                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_SELECTION                 Set a Selection                                             .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_SHEET_NAME                Sets the Name of a Worksheet                                .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_STYLE                     Set Style                                                   .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SET_ZOOM                      Set the Zoom Factor                                         .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SHOW_COLUMNS                  Display Columns                                             .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I SHOW_ROWS                     Display Rows                                                .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I UPDATE_FRONTEND               Change the Excel View Based on Data and Info Table          .
I_OI_SPREADSHEET               I VERSION                       Returns the Version of the Spreadsheet Interface            .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I ADD_TABLE                     Inserts an Internal Table in the Table Collection           .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I ADD_TABLE_BY_URL              Inserts an Internal Table in the Table Collection           .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I GET_TABLE                     Returns the Contents of an Internal Table                   .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I GET_TABLE_BY_URL              Returns the Contents of an Internal Table                   .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I REMOVE_ALL_TABLES             Removes all Tables                                          .
I_OI_TABLE_COLLECTION          I REMOVE_TABLE                  Removes all Tables                                          .
I_OI_TEMPLATE_DESIGNER         I ADD_SCHEMA                    Add Schema                                                  .
I_OI_TEMPLATE_DESIGNER         I CHECK_BINDINGS                Check Form Using Schema                                     .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I CLEAR_TABLE                   Delete the Contents of a Table in the Document              .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I GET_TABLE_INFO                Get the Number of Rows and Columns in Each Table in Document.
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I GET_TEMPLATE_INFO             Get the Name, Path, and Full Path of the Current Template   .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I GET_VERSION                   Get the Version of the Word Processor Application           .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I INSERT_TABLE                  Transfer Data from Internal Table to Document TAble         .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I INSERT_TABLE2                 Transfer Data to Document Table using Column Names          .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I INSTALL_TEMPLATE              Installs a Template for the Office Application              .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I REMOVE_TEMPLATE               Removes All Locally-Installed Templates                     .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I REPLACE                       Replaces a Character String in the Open Document            .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I SEARCH                        Finds a Character String in the Open Document               .
I_OI_WORD_PROCESSOR_DOCUMENT   I SET_TEMPLATE                  Sets Template for the Current Document                      .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I CALC_AMOUNT                   Calculate Sales-Based Rent                                  .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I CHANGE_LINE                   Change A Line                                               .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I CHANGE_POS_CURSOR             Change The Current Cursor Position                          .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I DISPLAY_LINE                  Display A Line                                              .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I ENDE                          Exit Editing                                                .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I FREE                          Release Memory                                              .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I GET_CURRENT_MASTER_DATA       Return Current Entry                                        .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I GET_CURRENT_SKOART_DATA4EDIT  Return Changed Values                                       .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I GET_TREE_ICON                 What Icon Do You Want For This Tree?                        .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I HAS_ANYTHING_CHANGED          Has Something Changed?                                      .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I SAVE_VALUES                   Save Values                                                 .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I SET_CURRENT_SKOART_DATA4EDIT  Transfer Change Values                                      .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I SET_ZERO_OR_INITIAL           Set To Zero Or Initial Value                                .
I_RE_UM_INPUT_VALUES           I USER_COMMAND                  Execute User Command                                        .
I_RE_UM_POSTING_TEMPLATE       I ADJUST_AP                     Adjust Advance Payments                                     .
I_RE_UM_POSTING_TEMPLATE       I BOOKING_AP                    Post Advance Payments                                       .
I_RE_UM_POSTING_TEMPLATE       I BOOKING_RECEIVABLES           Post Receivables                                            .
I_RE_UM_VIMI25_READ            I CLEAR_BUFFER                  Deletes Internal Memory                                     .
I_RE_UM_VIMI25_READ            I GET_VIMI25                    Load VIMI25 for Single CONTYP                               .
I_RE_UM_VIMI25_READ            I GET_VIMI25_MULTIPLE_SKOART    Load VIMI25 for Multiple cost types                         .
I_RE_UM_VIMI25_READ            I IS_PERIODS_SETTLED            If All Periods Are Settled - Reset Flag                     .
I_RE_UM_VIMI25_READ            I IS_PERIOD_SETTLED             If Past Period Is Settled Reset Flag                        .
*** End-of-List ***
All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
last update: Sun, 21/03/10 14:16:04

Impressum